À propos de la propriété intellectuelle Formation en propriété intellectuelle Respect de la propriété intellectuelle Sensibilisation à la propriété intellectuelle La propriété intellectuelle pour… Propriété intellectuelle et… Propriété intellectuelle et… Information relative aux brevets et à la technologie Information en matière de marques Information en matière de dessins et modèles industriels Information en matière d’indications géographiques Information en matière de protection des obtentions végétales (UPOV) Lois, traités et jugements dans le domaine de la propriété intellectuelle Ressources relatives à la propriété intellectuelle Rapports sur la propriété intellectuelle Protection des brevets Protection des marques Protection des dessins et modèles industriels Protection des indications géographiques Protection des obtentions végétales (UPOV) Règlement extrajudiciaire des litiges Solutions opérationnelles à l’intention des offices de propriété intellectuelle Paiement de services de propriété intellectuelle Décisions et négociations Coopération en matière de développement Appui à l’innovation Partenariats public-privé Outils et services en matière d’intelligence artificielle L’Organisation Travailler avec nous Responsabilité Brevets Marques Dessins et modèles industriels Indications géographiques Droit d’auteur Secrets d’affaires Académie de l’OMPI Ateliers et séminaires Application des droits de propriété intellectuelle WIPO ALERT Sensibilisation Journée mondiale de la propriété intellectuelle Magazine de l’OMPI Études de cas et exemples de réussite Actualités dans le domaine de la propriété intellectuelle Prix de l’OMPI Entreprises Universités Peuples autochtones Instances judiciaires Ressources génétiques, savoirs traditionnels et expressions culturelles traditionnelles Économie Financement Actifs incorporels Égalité des genres Santé mondiale Changement climatique Politique en matière de concurrence Objectifs de développement durable Technologies de pointe Applications mobiles Sport Tourisme PATENTSCOPE Analyse de brevets Classification internationale des brevets Programme ARDI – Recherche pour l’innovation Programme ASPI – Information spécialisée en matière de brevets Base de données mondiale sur les marques Madrid Monitor Base de données Article 6ter Express Classification de Nice Classification de Vienne Base de données mondiale sur les dessins et modèles Bulletin des dessins et modèles internationaux Base de données Hague Express Classification de Locarno Base de données Lisbon Express Base de données mondiale sur les marques relative aux indications géographiques Base de données PLUTO sur les variétés végétales Base de données GENIE Traités administrés par l’OMPI WIPO Lex – lois, traités et jugements en matière de propriété intellectuelle Normes de l’OMPI Statistiques de propriété intellectuelle WIPO Pearl (Terminologie) Publications de l’OMPI Profils nationaux Centre de connaissances de l’OMPI Série de rapports de l’OMPI consacrés aux tendances technologiques Indice mondial de l’innovation Rapport sur la propriété intellectuelle dans le monde PCT – Le système international des brevets ePCT Budapest – Le système international de dépôt des micro-organismes Madrid – Le système international des marques eMadrid Article 6ter (armoiries, drapeaux, emblèmes nationaux) La Haye – Le système international des dessins et modèles industriels eHague Lisbonne – Le système d’enregistrement international des indications géographiques eLisbon UPOV PRISMA UPOV e-PVP Administration UPOV e-PVP DUS Exchange Médiation Arbitrage Procédure d’expertise Litiges relatifs aux noms de domaine Accès centralisé aux résultats de la recherche et de l’examen (WIPO CASE) Service d’accès numérique aux documents de priorité (DAS) WIPO Pay Compte courant auprès de l’OMPI Assemblées de l’OMPI Comités permanents Calendrier des réunions WIPO Webcast Documents officiels de l’OMPI Plan d’action de l’OMPI pour le développement Assistance technique Institutions de formation en matière de propriété intellectuelle Mesures d’appui concernant la COVID-19 Stratégies nationales de propriété intellectuelle Assistance en matière d’élaboration des politiques et de formulation de la législation Pôle de coopération Centres d’appui à la technologie et à l’innovation (CATI) Transfert de technologie Programme d’aide aux inventeurs WIPO GREEN Initiative PAT-INFORMED de l’OMPI Consortium pour des livres accessibles L’OMPI pour les créateurs WIPO Translate Speech-to-Text Assistant de classification États membres Observateurs Directeur général Activités par unité administrative Bureaux extérieurs Avis de vacance d’emploi Achats Résultats et budget Rapports financiers Audit et supervision
Arabic English Spanish French Russian Chinese
Lois Traités Jugements Recherche par ressort juridique

Lois de Nioué (législation en 1 décembre 2006), Nioué

Retour
Texte remplacé  Accéder à la dernière version dans WIPO Lex
Détails Détails Année de version 2006 Dates Réédité le: 1 décembre 2006 Type de texte Autres textes Sujet Droit d'auteur, Propriété industrielle, Marques, Expressions culturelles traditionnelles, Savoirs traditionnels, Brevets (Inventions), Mise en application des droits Notes This reprint of the Niue Laws (Legislation as at 1 December 2006) is divided into 4 volumns of legislation of Niue (Volumes 1 to Volumes 4). These volumns contains legislation related to intellectual property rights, which include, inter alia, the following: 1)Niue Act 1966; 2)Archives Act 1992; 3)Companies Act 2006; 4)Customs Act 1966; 5)Crown Proceedings Act 1950; 6)Income Tax Act 1961; 7)Merchandise Marks Act 1954; 8)Meteorological Services Act 2013; 9)Partnership Amendment Act 1994; 10)Tāoga Niue Act 2012; 11)Tobacco Control Act 2018; 12)Trustee Act 1956.

Documents disponibles

Texte(s) principal(aux) Textes connexe(s)
Texte(s) supplémentaire(s) Volume(s) (1 texte(s)) Volume(s) (1 texte(s)) Anglais Niue Laws (Legislation as at 1 December 2006) 1       2       3       4      
NIUE LAWS, VOLUME 1

NIUE LAWS

TAU FAKATUFONO-TOHI A NIUE

LEGISLATION AS AT DECEMBER 2006

VOLUME 1 TOHI 1

CONSTITUTION

STATUTES

A – COMPANIES

GOVERNMENT OF NIUE, ALOFI

2006

Copyright 2006 All rights reserved

Enquiries concerning the copyright material

should be addressed to the

Crown Law Office, Alofi, Niue

Compiled in the Faculty of Law, Victoria University of Wellington

by Professor AH Angelo with the assistance of Nicola Scott

Printed by Stylex Print, Palmerston North, New Zealand

FAKATUFONO NIUE FOREWORD

It is with considerable pride that I present this consolidated collection of the laws of

Niue to the Speaker and Members of the Assembly, to the members of the Niue

Public Service, to my colleagues in Government, and to the people of Niue.

This is the first ever statement of Niue's identity through a collection of its contemporary law. Following the enactment of the Constitution in 1974, most of our laws continued in their pre-1974 form without adaptation to the changed status of Niue. The passage of time has shown many of those laws to be irrelevant, inappropriate or difficult of interpretation.

We now have in these volumes a statement which reflects our current situation: the references are to Niue officials and to Niue institutions. We now have a clear basis from which to move for reform of our laws.

Members of the Assembly need no longer be in doubt as to what is the law of Niue and what is not. To the extent that what is in. these volumes is considered inappropriate to Niue in the 21st century, it is for Government, the Members of Assembly, and the nation as a whole to make reforms to reflect what is appropriate.

Getting to this stage has been made possible by grants of assistance from NZAID and by the volunteer effort of many people both in Niue and in New Zealand. I wish to record our sincere thanks to those who have participated in this project and contributed to its success. To name a few: Togia Sioneholo who oversaw the initiation of the Niue Legislation Review, to Peleni Talagi who guided the major law revision Bills through the legislative process, to Sinahemana Hekau who has managed the project through to its completion, and to Professor Angelo and his team.

The laws in these volumes have been prepared and printed under the Reprint of Statutes Act 1991 and, consistent with Cabinet decision, have the status accorded by that Act

I commend this collection of laws of Niue to all concerned with the administration

- a....w_

of Niue, and celebrate it as a signal of our nationhood.

Niue Laws 2006 Voll

CONTENTS

Foreword ................................................................................................................ iii

Editorial Note ........................................................................................................ xi

VOLUME ONE

PART 1 – LEGISLATION TABLES

Table of Constitutional Instruments .................................................................. xv

Table of Acts in Force ........................................................................................... xvii

Chronological Table of Statutes .......................................................................... xxxi

Table of Subsidiary Legislation in Force ............................................................ xlv

Chronological Table of Subsidiary Legislation ................................................. lv

CONSTITUTIONAL INSTRUMENTS
Constitution of Niue ............................................................................................. 1
Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue ................................................................ 29
Niue Constitution Act 1974 ................................................................................. 63
Letters Patent Constituting the Office of Governor-General of New Zealand 65
Seal of New Zealand Proclamation .................................................................... 71

ACTS

Administration Act 1969 ...................................................................................... 73

Adoption Act 1955 ................................................................................................ 99

Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984 ....................................................................... 103

Appropriation (Annual) Act 2006 ...................................................................... 111

Arbitration Act 1908 ............................................................................................. 117

Arbitration Amendment Act 1938 ...................................................................... 123

Arbitration Clauses (Protocol) and the Arbitration (Foreign Awards)

Act 1933 ............................................................................................................. 129

Archives Act 1992 ................................................................................................. 135

Arms Act 1975 ....................................................................................................... 141

Assembly Members’ Superannuation Act 1984 ............................................... 151

Atomic Energy Act 1945 ...................................................................................... 153

Aviation Crimes Act 1973 .................................................................................... 159

Bills of Exchange Act 1908 ................................................................................... 167

Broadcasting Act 1989 .......................................................................................... 195

Building Code Act 1992 ....................................................................................... 207

Business Licence Act 1997 ................................................................................... 215

Carriage by Air Act 1992 ...................................................................................... 223

Census Act 1971 .................................................................................................... 227

Chattels Transfer Act 1924 ................................................................................... 233

Cheques Act 1960 .................................................................................................. 257

Child Allowance Act 1995 ................................................................................... 259

Citizenship Act 1977 ............................................................................................. 263

Civil Aviation Act 1999 ......................................................................................... 283

Civil List Act 1999 ................................................................................................. 305

Commissions of Inquiry Act 1968 ...................................................................... 309

Communications Act 1989 ................................................................................... 313

Companies Act 2006 ............................................................................................. 325

v

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

VOLUME TWO

Constitutional Polls Act 1977 .................................................................................. 585
Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971 ..................................................... 587
Continental Shelf Act 1964 ...................................................................................... 613
Crimes against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages Act 1984 ...... 617
Crown Proceedings Act 1950 .................................................................................. 625
Customs Act 1966 ..................................................................................................... 641
Customs Tariff Act 1982 ........................................................................................... 717
Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952 ...................................................... 719
Departure Tax Act 1996 ............................................................................................ 727
Development Investment Act 1992 ........................................................................ 729
Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968 .................................................. 743
Dogs Act 1966 ............................................................................................................ 761
Domestic Fishing Act 1995 ...................................................................................... 769
Education Act 1989 ................................................................................................... 777
Electric Power Supply Act 1960 .............................................................................. 793
Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985 ............................................................. 799
Environment Act 2003 .............................................................................................. 809
Extradition Act 1965 ................................................................................................. 821
Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979 ............................................................... 823
Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006 ........................................................... 837
Fireworks Act 1958 ................................................................................................... 859
Food Control Act 1981 .............................................................................................. 861
Fugitive Offenders Act 1881 .................................................................................... 869
General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade Act 1948 .............................................. 871
General Laws Act 1968 ............................................................................................. 873
Geneva Conventions Act 1958 ................................................................................ 877
Government Loans Act 1980 ................................................................................... 885
Guardianship Act 1968 ............................................................................................. 891
Income Tax Act 1961 ................................................................................................. 901
Incorporated Societies Act 1908 .............................................................................. 965
Inquest Act 1964 ........................................................................................................ 977
International Finance Agreements Act 1961 ......................................................... 989
International Finance Agreements Amendment Act 1966 .................................. 995
Interpretation Act 2004 ............................................................................................. 999
Land Act 1969 .......................................................................................................... 1009
Liquor Act 1975 ....................................................................................................... 1025
Manufactured Goods Tax Act 1964 ...................................................................... 1031
Marine Insurance Act 1908 .................................................................................... 1035
Mercantile Law Act 1908 ....................................................................................... 1059
Merchandise Marks Act 1954 ................................................................................ 1073
Mining Act 1977 ...................................................................................................... 1085
Minors’ Contracts Act 1969 ................................................................................... 1097
Misuse of Drugs Act 1975 ...................................................................................... 1103
Misuse of Drugs Act 1998 ...................................................................................... 1103
Mosquito Control Act 1980 .................................................................................... 1105
Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998 ............................................... 1107
vi

VOLUME THREE

National Disaster Relief Fund Act 1980 ............................................................... 1133
New Zealand Representative Act 1981 ................................................................ 1135
Niue Act 1966 .......................................................................................................... 1139
Niue Amendment Act 1968 (No 2) ....................................................................... 1231
Niue Assembly Act 1966 ........................................................................................ 1253
Niue Bank Act 1994 ................................................................................................ 1297
Niue Certification Authority Act 1978 ................................................................. 1333
Niue Cultural Council Act 1986 ............................................................................ 1335
Niue Development Bank Act 1993 ....................................................................... 1339
Niue Development Bonds Act 1994 ..................................................................... 1355
Niue Flag Act 1975 .................................................................................................. 1365
Niue Philatelic and Numismatic Act 1996 .......................................................... 1367
Niue Trust Fund Act 2004 ...................................................................................... 1371
Occupiers Liability Act 1962 ................................................................................. 1373
Partnership Act 1908 .............................................................................................. 1377
Partnership Application Act 1994 ......................................................................... 1391
Pensions and Benefits Act 1991 ............................................................................. 1399
Pesticides Act 1991 .................................................................................................. 1405
Pig Control Act 1998 ............................................................................................... 1411
Price Control on Imported Goods for Resale in Niue Act 1975 ....................... 1417
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 ................................................................................... 1421
Property Law Act 1952 ........................................................................................... 1459
Public Emergency Act 1979 ................................................................................... 1487
Public Health Act 1965 ........................................................................................... 1491
Public Notaries Act 1998 ........................................................................................ 1511
Public Revenues Act 1959 ...................................................................................... 1513
Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980 ............................................ 1525
Race Relations Act 1972 ......................................................................................... 1535
Reprint of Statutes Act 1991 .................................................................................. 1543
Royal Titles Act 1974 .............................................................................................. 1545
Sale of Goods Act 1908 ........................................................................................... 1547
Seal of New Zealand Act 1977 .............................................................................. 1563
Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1997 .................................... 1565
Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006 ............................ 1587
Tourist Authority Act 1995 .................................................................................... 1607
Transport Act 1965 .................................................................................................. 1615
Trustee Act 1956 ...................................................................................................... 1651
Trustee Companies Act 1994 ................................................................................. 1699
Trusts Act 1994 ........................................................................................................ 1701
United Nations Act 1946 ........................................................................................ 1729
Village Councils Act 1967 ...................................................................................... 1731
Visiting Forces Act 1939 ......................................................................................... 1747
Water Resources Act 1996 ...................................................................................... 1753
Wildlife Act 1972 ..................................................................................................... 1767
Wills Act 1837 .......................................................................................................... 1771
Wills Act Amendment Act 1852 ............................................................................ 1779
Wreck and Salvage Act 1968 .................................................................................. 1781
vii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

VOLUME FOUR

CONSTITUTION OF NIUE

Niue Assembly Standing Orders .......................................................................... 1
Public Service Regulations .................................................................................... 26

AGRICULTURE QUARANTINE ACT 1985

Animal Quarantine (Disease Control) Regulations ........................................... 49
Agricultural Quarantine Phytosanitary Certificates (Fees) Regulations ........ 52
Animal Quarantine (Fees) Regulations ............................................................... 52
Agricultural Quarantine (Prevention of Animal Disease) Regulations .......... 53
Plant Quarantine Regulations ............................................................................... 57

ARMS ACT 1974

Arms Registration (Fees) Regulations ................................................................. 67

BROADCASTING ACT 1989

Broadcasting Regulations ...................................................................................... 69

BUILDING CODE ACT 1992 .............................................................................. 73

BUSINESS LICENCE ACT 1997

Business Licence Regulations ............................................................................... 75

CHATTELS TRANSFER ACT 1924

Chattels Transfer Fees Regulations ...................................................................... 77

CHILD ALLOWANCE ACT 1995

Child Allowance (Fees) Regulations .................................................................... 79

CIVIL AVIATION ACT 1999 ............................................................................... 81

COMMUNICATIONS ACT

Radio Regulations ................................................................................................... 83
Telephone Regulations ........................................................................................... 108

CUSTOMS ACT 1966

Customs Regulations ............................................................................................. 123
Export Licences Regulations ................................................................................. 157
Export Prohibition Regulations ............................................................................ 160
Import Prohibition (Insecticides) Order .............................................................. 161
Import Prohibition (Offensive Weapons) Order ................................................ 161
Port and Service Tax Regulations ......................................................................... 162

CUSTOMS TARIFF ACT 1982

Customs Tariff (General Amendments) Regulations ........................................ 163
Customs Tariff (Reduction and Elimination of Tariffs) Regulations ............... 164

DEPARTURE TAX ACT 1996

Departure Travel Tax Regulations ........................................................................ 167

DIPLOMATIC PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES ACT 1968 ..................... 169

viii

Contents

DOGS ACT 1966

Dogs (Fees) Regulations ........................................................................................ 171

DOMESTIC FISHING ACT 1995

Domestic Fishing Regulations .............................................................................. 173

ENTRY, RESIDENCE AND DEPARTURE TAX ACT 1985

Entry, Residence and Departure Regulations ..................................................... 179

ENVIRONMENT ACT 2003

Biosafety (Genetically Modified Organisms) Regulations ............................... 183

EXTRADITION ACT 1965 ................................................................................... 197

FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT ACT 1979

Film and Public Entertainment (Fees) Regulations ........................................... 199

GENERAL LAWS ACT 1968

Maritime Security Regulations ............................................................................. 201

INCORPORATED SOCIETIES ACT 1908

Incorporated Societies Regulations ...................................................................... 233

LIQUOR ACT 1975

Liquor (Breweries) Regulations ............................................................................ 237

MISUSE OF DRUGS ACT 1975 .......................................................................... 243

NIUE ACT 1966

Audit Regulations ................................................................................................... 245
Births and Deaths Registration Regulations ....................................................... 252
Co-operative Societies Regulations ...................................................................... 268
Dental Regulations ................................................................................................. 283
Gaming (Fees) Regulations ................................................................................... 284
High Court Rules .................................................................................................... 285
Land Court Rules .................................................................................................... 309
Land Registration Regulations ............................................................................. 327
Marriage Regulations ............................................................................................. 337
Penal Manual ........................................................................................................... 344
Sea Carriage of Goods Act 1940 ............................................................................ 364

NIUE BANK ACT 1994

Niue Bank Regulations .......................................................................................... 371

PARTNERSHIP ACT 1908

Partnership Amendment Fees Regulations ........................................................ 375

PARTNERSHIP APPLICATION ACT 1994

Partnership Amendment Forms Regulations ..................................................... 377

PENSIONS AND BENEFITS ACT 1991

Pensions and Benefits Regulations ...................................................................... 381
ix

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

PUBLIC HEALTH ACT 1965

Notifiable Disease Notice ...................................................................................... 383

PUBLIC REVENUES ACT 1959

Treasury Rules ......................................................................................................... 385

TERRITORIAL SEA AND EXCLUSIVE ECONOMIC ZONE ACT 1997

Whale Sanctuary Regulations ............................................................................... 391

TRANSPORT ACT 1965

Transport (Fees) Regulations ................................................................................. 393

TRUSTEE ACT 1956

Trustees’ Commission Rules ................................................................................. 395

TRUSTEE COMPANIES ACT 1994 .................................................................... 399

UNITED NATIONS ACT 1946

United Nations Sanctions (Terrorism Suppression and Afghanistan
Measures) Regulations ........................................................................................... 401

VISITING FORCES ACT 1939

Visiting Forces (Commonwealth Deserters and Absentees) Order ................. 405
Visiting Forces Order .............................................................................................. 405
Visiting Forces (Penal Arrangements) Order ...................................................... 406
Visiting Forces (Relative Ranks) Regulations ..................................................... 407

WILDLIFE ACT 1972

Wildlife Protected Species Notice ......................................................................... 411
x

EDITORIAL NOTE

This is the first ever presentation of the law of Niue in a consolidated form. There have been earlier collections of the legislation of Niue, but most have been partial in the sense that they did not include all of the legislation. Even the major collection of 1990 was a reproduction of texts rather than an edited contemporary statement of the Niue law. None of the earlier collections had statutory authority.
Since 1990, the occasional collections of enacted legislation have enabled reasonable access to the law of Niue. What has been lacking has been a post-self-determination statement of the law of Niue in a consolidated and up-to-date form with all the editing necessary to take account of the separation from the Cook Islands, the impact of the 1974 Constitution, and the post-1974 devolutions of authority and changes in the names of public service positions.
The groundwork for an official statement of the law of Niue was laid in 1991 with the passing of the Reprint of Statutes Act 1991. Further action, however, was not taken until 2001 with the establishment of a Legislation Review Project. This review had the task of addressing those areas of Niue law where the ordinary legislation was incompatible with the Constitution, where regulations were ultra vires current statutes, and where existing law had ceased to be relevant because of changes of circumstance in Niue.
The review priority was to establish a clear statement of the existing operative law. To that end, a new Interpretation Act was prepared and passed by the Niue Assembly in 2004 and, reflecting the initial results of the review, the Legislation (Correction of Errors and Minor Amendments) Act 2004 was also promulgated. These Acts were followed by the Minor Amendments No 2 Act 2006.
The support of the Assembly, by its clearing away of the incorrect, the obsolete, and the removal of ambiguities, meant an accessible set of the laws could be published. The present volumes are the result. They provide the basis for a thorough-going reform of the legislation of Niue in areas given priority by the Government.
The research done for the review disclosed a number of anomalies which have mostly been attended to by amending legislation or reform legislation since 2003. Some anomalies remain and these are under active consideration by the Government as part of its legislation programme.
Of particular historical interest in Niue law has been the interrelationship of the law of Niue and the law of New Zealand. Until 1974, much of the legislation for Niue came in the form of Acts of the New Zealand Parliament. Most of those Acts were either not adapted to the Niue circumstance, or were inadequately adapted. The result was a system of some awkwardness and uncertainty. Most of the uncertainties have now been resolved by Niue legislative action: In some cases by adapting the law to the Niue administrative structures, in other cases by making clear whether the legislation was a long arm jurisdiction of New Zealand or whether the statute was a law of Niue. Additionally, there were a number of examples of New Zealand statutes being extended to Niue as Niue law by way of subsidiary enactment. The Marine Pollution Act 1974 and the Sea Carriage of Goods Act 1940 are examples of this pattern. They both now appear as subsidiary
xi

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

legislation made under the Niue Act 1966. This is apparently anomalous because it is subsidiary legislation which is designated as an Act and which, in the case of the Marine Pollution Act 1974, is legislation which has subsidiary legislation of its own. For the future therefore, the Niue Government may alter these laws by way of regulation or, alternatively, the Assembly may repeal them and replace them with a new statute. The matter was complicated between 1974 and 2004 by the fact that the general regulation-making power in the Niue Act 1966 was abrogated at the time of self-government. It was therefore necessary to amend the Niue Act
1966 to insert a new regulation-making power.
Exceptionally, some legislation has not been reproduced in these volumes. Where that is the case, the text is annotated at the appropriate page. The prime examples of omissions are Acts which deal with treaty arrangements. In such cases, the texts are not of everyday relevance to the operation of the legal system and are readily available for public access on the internet. Other examples of omissions are those substantial bodies of law which deal in detail with particular areas of administration: The National Building Code (available from the Director of Works), the Customs Tariff (available from the Revenue Manager, Customs) and the Sanitary Regulations of the WHO (available in their latest form on the internet).
In former times, a number of laws of Niue included the word ‘Niue’ in their title, presumably to distinguish that piece of legislation from similar legislation in another part of the Realm of New Zealand. In this collection, the word ‘Niue’ has usually been omitted and each of the Acts affected now appears under its key word in the appropriate alphabetical place eg the Dogs Act, the Fireworks Act, the General Laws Act, the Inquest Act, the Manufactured Goods Tax Act, the Public Health Act, the Transport Act, and the Village Councils Act.
This collection has been prepared under the Reprint of Statutes Act 1991 and aims to present the law using a uniform layout and uniform formulae.
Reform of the law of Niue and improvements for its accessibility will build on this publication and continue in the context of the Legislation Review Project.
AH Angelo
NM Scott
xii

PART 1

LEGISLATION TABLES

Niue Laws 2006 Voll

xiv

TABLE OF CONSTITUTIONAL INSTRUMENTS

This table lists the key texts of the Niue Constitution as at 1 December 2006.

Title Instrument

Amendment

Constitution of Niue Schedule to 1974/42 (NZ)

1992/162

Niue Constitution Act 1974 1974/42 (NZ) Letters Patent constituting the Office of SR 1983/225

Governor-General of New Zealand SR 1987/8

SR 2006/224

Seal of New Zealand Proclamation SR 1977/29

xv

Niue Laws 2006 Voll

xvi

TABLE OF ACTS IN FORCE

This table lists the statutes in force in Niue as at December 2006.

Unless indicated by ‘G’, ‘(NZ)’, ‘SR’, or otherwise, references are to Niue statutes.’‘ G 1970, III, 2318’ indicates the New Zealand Gazette, 1970, vol III, p 2318.

Title Main Instrument

Amendments

Administration Act 1969 1969/52 (NZ)

1970/45 (NZ)

1972/43 (NZ)

1972/130 (NZ)

1973/47 (NZ)

2004/270

Adoption Act 1955 (ss 16(1), 16(2), 20(6) only) 1955/93 (NZ)

[Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 (NZ), ss 99, 100]

Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984 1984/99

1989/136

2004/270

Appropriation (Annual) Act 2006 2006/277

Arbitration Act 1908 1908/8 (NZ)

1915/13 (NZ)

1952/27 (NZ)

2004/270

Arbitration Amendment Act 1938 1938/6 (NZ)

2004/270

Arbitration Clauses (Protocol) and the 1933/4 (NZ) Arbitration Foreign Awards) Act 1933 1957/44 (NZ)

2004/270

Archives Act 1992 1992/166

Arms Act 1975 1975/4

1998/234

cp reg 2005/1

xvii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Assembly Members’ Superannuation Act 1984 1984/96

Atomic Energy Act 1945

1945/41 (NZ)

[s 3]

1957/12 (NZ)

1957/87 (NZ)

1961/54 (NZ)

1961/68 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1971/25 (NZ)

1976/26

1977/30

2004/270

Aviation Crimes Act 1973

1973/82

1993/173

1999/250

2004/270

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

1908/15 (NZ)

1946/40 (NZ)

1960/17 (NZ)

1963/75 (NZ)

1971/21 (NZ)

2004/270

Broadcasting Act 1989

1989/132

1997/225

2004/270

2006/279

Building Code Act 1992

1992/165

2006/279

Business Licence Act 1997

1997/216

Carriage by Air Act 1967

1967/151 (NZ)

[s 3(2)]

1968/39 (NZ)

1971/52 (NZ)

1972/43 (NZ)

1973/6 (NZ)

1974/43 (NZ)

2004/270

2006/279

Census Act 1971

1971/68

1976/21

2004/270

2006/279

xviii

Table of Acts

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

1924/49 (NZ)

G 1925 II 1517

G 1925 III 3055

G 1925 III 3353

1925/21 (NZ)

G 1926 II 1805

G 1928 II 2465

G 1930 II 1509

1931/34 (NZ)

G 1933 III 2734

G 1935 III 2275

1936/58 (NZ)

SR 1938/49

1939/39 (NZ)

1940/18 (NZ)

SR 1940/311

1943/20 (NZ)

1945/40 (NZ)

SR 1950/68

1952/25 (NZ)

SR 1953/45

1953/79 (NZ)

SR 1953/149

1954/50 (NZ)

SR 1954/78

SR 1955/148

SR 1956/146

SR 1957/33

SR 1960/85

1961/75 (NZ)

SR 1962/7

SR 1962/47

1963/78 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

SR 1965/26

1967/60 (NZ)

SR 1968/87

1969/71 (NZ)

SR 1969/110

SR 1969/253

1970/29 (NZ)

SR 1970/244

1971/147 (NZ)

1972/130 (NZ)

1973/52 (NZ)

2004/270

2006/279

xix

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Cheques Act 1960

1960/17 (NZ)

2004/270

Child Allowance Act 1995

1995/203

2004/272

Citizenship Act 1977

1977/61 (NZ)

[s 29; art 36 Constitution]

Civil Aviation Act 1999

1999/250

2006/279

Civil List Act 1999

1999/248

2001/255

2004/265

Communications Act 1989

1989/131

2000/251

Commissions of Inquiry Act 1968

1968/50

2004/270

Companies Act 2006

2006/275

Reg 2006/2

Constitutional Polls Act 1977

1977/28

1992/161

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

1971/11 (NZ)

[s 12]

1974/43 (NZ)

2004/270

Continental Shelf Act 1964

1964/28 (NZ)

[s 9]

1964/27 (NZ)

1965/11 (NZ)

1972/4 (NZ)

1974/43 (NZ)

2004/270

Crimes against Internationally Protected

1984/86

Persons and Hostages Act 1984

xx

Table of Acts

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

Customs Act 1966

Customs Tariff Act 1982

Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952

1950/54 (NZ)

1952/35 (NZ)

1952/51 (NZ)

1952/56 (NZ)

1956/47 (NZ)

1958/61 (NZ)

1961/68 (NZ)

1962/19 (NZ)

1962/120 (NZ)

1963/38 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1969/74 (NZ)

1972/130 (NZ)

2004/270

1966/19 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1967/1 (NZ)

1967/137 (NZ)

1968/31 (NZ)

1968/39 (NZ)

1969/137 (NZ)

1970/28 (NZ)

1970/137 (NZ)

1971/38 (NZ)

1971/42 (NZ)

1972/7 (NZ)

1973/6 (NZ)

1973/110 (NZ)

1974/4 (NZ)

1974/18 (NZ)

1982/77

2004/270

2006/279

1982/77

1988/129

1992/164/s4

1952/35 (NZ)

1961/6 (NZ)

1964/40 (NZ)

1969/18 (NZ)

1972/43 (NZ)

2004/270

xxi

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Departure Tax Act 1996 1996/212

Development Investment Act 1992 1992/164

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968 1968/36 (NZ)

[s 25(1)] 1969/78 (NZ)

1971/11 (NZ)

1971/96 (NZ)

1974/43 (NZ)

2004/270

Dogs Act 1966 1966/35

1966/39

1982/79

1974/93

2004/270

Domestic Fishing Act 1995 1995/199

Education Act 1989 1989/130

1997/229

Electric Power Supply Act 1960 1960/6

2004/270

Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985 1985/106

1989/142

1995/201

Environment Act 2003 2003/264

2006/279

Extradition Act 1965 1965/44 (NZ)

[Niue Act, s 320] 1964/27 (NZ)

1966/39 (NZ)

1967/54 (NZ)

1967/75 (NZ)

1969/17 (NZ)

1969/76 (NZ)

1969/78 (NZ)

1970/27 (NZ)

SR 1970/240

1972/137 (NZ)

1973/82

1975/116 (NZ)

1984/86

1998/242

xxii

Table of Acts

Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979

1979/45

1984/95

1992/169

2004/270

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

2006/278

Fireworks Act 1958

1958/56

Food Control Act 1981

1981/70

Fugitive Offenders Act 1881

44 & 45 Vict, c 69 (UK)

[Crimes against Internationally Protected

5 & 6 Geo 5, c 39 (UK)

Persons and Hostages Act 1984, s 16]

SR & O 1922/77 (UK)

1976/2 (NZ)

General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade

1948/1 (NZ)

Act 1948

1961/57 (NZ)

1966/19 (NZ)

General Laws Act 1968

1968/52

2004/267

Geneva Conventions Act 1958

1958/19 (NZ)

[s 10]

1961/68 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1964/70 (NZ)

1965/1 (NZ)

1969/78 (NZ)

1971/53 (NZ)

1974/43 (NZ)

Government Loans Act 1980

1980/56

Guardianship Act 1968

1968/63

2004/270

2006/279

Income Tax Act 1961

1961/9

1964/20

1965/29

1967/46

1977/31

1978/41

1984/83

1987/118

1988/126

1992/164/s4

xxiii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1994/177

1994/181/s7

1998/238

1999/247

2004/270

Incorporated Societies Act 1908

1908/212 (NZ)

1920/50 (NZ)

1922/27 (NZ)

1930/17 (NZ)

1951/38 (NZ)

1953/80 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1965/88 (NZ)

1971/43 (NZ)

1971/51 (NZ)

2004/270

International Finance Agreements Act 1961

1961/3 (NZ)

1966/25 (NZ)

Interpretation Act 2004

2004/269

Inquest Act 1964

1964/23

1975/13

Land Act 1969

1969/57

1977/30

1984/94

2004/269

2004/270

Liquor Act 1975

1975/2

1980/53

1991/150

1997/226

1998/239

Manufactured Goods Tax Act 1964

1964/21

1967/47

1969/58

1971/69

1981/69

2004/270

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1908/112 (NZ)

1960/11 (NZ)

xxiv

Table of Acts

Mercantile Law Act 1908

Merchandise Marks Act 1954

Mining Act 1977

Minors’ Contracts Act 1969

Misuse of Drugs Act 1975

[s 41; Niue Act, s 689A]

Misuse of Drugs Act 1998

Mosquito Control Act 1980

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

National Disaster Relief Fund Act 1980

New Zealand Representative Act 1981

Niue Act 1966

[s 3]

1908/117 (NZ)

1922/25 (NZ)

1938/6 (NZ)

1948/66 (NZ)

1950/65 (NZ)

2004/270

1954/43 (NZ)

1954/76 (NZ)

SR 1955/101

1961/68 (NZ)

1961/123 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1972/107 (NZ)

2004/270

1977/30

1969/41 (NZ)

1970/88 (NZ)

1970/137 (NZ)

1971/111 (NZ)

1972/95 (NZ)

2004/270

1975/116 (NZ)

1998/243

1980/63

2004/270

1998/244

2006/276

1980/61

1981/69

1966/38 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1967/38 (NZ)

1968/15 (NZ)

1968/132 (NZ)

1969/16 (NZ)

1969/17 (NZ)

xxv

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1969/205 (NZ)

1969/232 (NZ)

1970/15 (NZ)

1971/66

1971/143 (NZ)

1974/43 (NZ)

1974/110 (NZ)

1975/2

1975/5

1975/9

1975/116 (NZ)

SR 1975/279

1976/26

1976/30 (NZ)

1976/122 (NZ)

1977/1 (NZ)

1977/29

1977/61 (NZ)

1980/59

1982/76

1983/128 (NZ)

1984/91

1984/98

1986/31 (NZ)

1989/131

1989/133

1989/134

1991/153

1996/207

1996/214

1997/219

1998/232

1999/246

2004/269

2004/270

2005/273

2006/278

2006/279

Niue Amendment (No. 2) Act 1968

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1968/132 (NZ)

2004/270

1966/33

1975/7

1982/79

1992/168

2004/270

xxvi

Table of Acts

Niue Bank Act 1994

1994/177

2006/278

2006/279

Niue Certification Authority Act 1978

1978/36

Niue Cultural Council Act 1986

1986/109

Niue Development Bank Act 1993

1993/189

1996/208

Niue Development Bonds Act 1994

1994/181

1994/194

2006/279

Niue Flag Act 1975

1975/16

2006/279

Niue Philatelic and Numismatic Act 1996

1996/206

2003/262

Niue Trust Fund Act 2004

2004/266

Occupiers Liability Act 1962

1962/31 (NZ)

2004/270

Partnership Act 1908

1908/139 (NZ)

1947/60 (NZ)

1965/124 (NZ)

2004/270

2006/279

Partnership Application Act 1994

1994/180

Pensions and Benefits Act 1991

1991/157

1995/202

2001/256

2004/271

Pesticides Act 1991

1991/158

Pig Control Act 1998

1998/231

Price Control on Imported Goods for Resale

1975/5

in Niue Act 1975

1991/152

2004/270

xxvii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

Property Law Act 1952

Public Emergency Act 1979

Public Health Act 1965

Public Notaries Act 1998

Public Revenues Act 1959

Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980

Race Relations Act 1972

1998/245

1952/51 (NZ)

1953/4 (NZ)

1955/94 (NZ)

1956/61 (NZ)

1957/39 (NZ)

1958/37 (NZ)

1959/31 (NZ)

1963/60 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1965/16 (NZ)

1967/111 (NZ)

1968/101 (NZ)

1969/16 (NZ)

1969/52 (NZ)

1970/137 (NZ)

1971/51 (NZ)

1971/121 (NZ)

2004/270

1979/51

1965/24

1980/63

1980/64

1996/209

2004/270

1998/236

1959/1

1974/89

1989/138

1989/144

1990/144

1991/159

2004/269

2004/270

2006/279

1980/55

2004/270

1972/77

2004/270

2006/279

xxviii

Table of Acts

Reprint of Statutes Act 1991

1991/154

2004/270

Royal Titles Act 1974

[s 3]

1974/1 (NZ)

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1908/168 (NZ)

1956/23 (NZ)

1961/98 (NZ)

1969/41 (NZ)

1971/80 (NZ)

Seal of New Zealand Act 1977

[s 7]

1977/1 (NZ)

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone

Act 1997

1997/220

2006/279

2006/281

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational

Crimes Act 2006

2006/280

Tourist Authority Act 1995

1995/200

1997/224

2003/263

Transport Act 1965

1965/30

1976/24

1977/33

1982/79

1990/148

1990/149

1996/213

1997/221

2004/270

Trustee Act 1956

1956/61 (NZ)

1956/63 (NZ)

1957/36 (NZ)

1957/37 (NZ)

1960/101 (NZ)

1962/107 (NZ)

1963/21 (NZ)

1963/46 (NZ)

1964/9 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

1964/74 (NZ)

xxix

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1965/22 (NZ)

1965/7 (NZ)

1968/24 (NZ)

1968/43 (NZ)

1969/16 (NZ)

1969/52 (NZ)

1969/110 (NZ)

1970/5 (NZ)

1971/51 (NZ)

1971/137 (NZ)

1974/8 (NZ)

1974/15 (NZ)

1974/19 (NZ)

SR 1974/109

2004/270

Trustee Companies Act 1994

1994/183

Trusts Act 1994

1994/182

1994/194

United Nations Act 1946

1946/7 (NZ)

[s 4]

1961/68 (NZ)

1964/27 (NZ)

2001/257

2004/270

Village Councils Act 1967

1967/41

2004/270

Visiting Forces Act 1939

1939/36 (NZ)

[s 7]

1957/32 (NZ)

1961/68 (NZ)

1961/107 (NZ)

1971/52 (NZ)

2004/270

Water Resources Act 1996

1996/209

2006/279

Wildlife Act 1972

1972/74

Wills Act 1837

1 Will IV (UK)

Wills Act Amendment Act 1852

15 & 16 Vict, c 24 (UK)

Wreck and Salvage Act 1968

1968/53

2004/270

xxx

CHRONOLOGICAL TABLE OF STATUTES

This table lists the statutes enacted by the Island Council of Niue from 1916 to

1959, by the Niue Island Assembly from 1959 to 1974, and by the Niue Assembly

from 19 October 1974 to 1 December 2006. It records how the enactments have

been affected by subsequent legislation and lapse of time.

All references are to Acts of the Niue Assembly unless indicated by (NZ).


Year

No.

Title

Status

1916

1

Copra

Repealed by 1969/60

2

Traders’ Hours of Business

Repealed by 1958/55

3

Fish Protection

Repealed by 1965/32

4

Traffic Regulation

Repealed by 1950/41

5

Dog Registration

Repealed by 1966/35

6

Aid to Revenue

Repealed by 1945/36

1917

7

Aid to Revenue

Amended 1916/6

8

Road-Cleaning

Repealed by 1965/30

9

Coconut Plantations

Repealed by 1926/27

1918

10

Sales of Coconuts Prohibition

Repealed by 1969/60

11

Emigration

Repealed by 1923/19

12

Sanitation

Repealed by 1965/24

1919

13

Education Regulations Extension

Disallowed1

14

Suppression of Immorality

Repealed by 1968/52

15

Public Health

Repealed by 1965/24

1920

16

Aid to Revenue Continuance

Repealed by 1945/36

17

Traders’ Hours of Business

Amended 1916/2

1Disallowed by the Governor-General pursuant to the Cook Islands Act 1915 (NZ), s 88, by notice published in the New

Zealand Gazette 20 May 1920, 1567.

xxxi

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1923

18

Aid to Revenue Continuance

Repealed by 1945/36

19

Emigration Repeal

Spent

20

Water-Supply

Repealed by 1965/24

21

Fish Protection

Disallowed2

22

Debt Limitation

Repealed by 1967/43

1924

23

Daylight-Saving

Repealed by 1926/25

1926

24

Aid to Revenue Continuance

Repealed by 1945/36

25

Daylight-Saving Repeal

Spent

26

Water-Supply

Amended 1923/20

27

Planting of Lands

Repealed by 1963/18

1927

28

Traders’ Hours of Business

Amended 1916/2

29

Permit

Repealed by 1969/55

30

Traffic Regulation

Amended 1916/4

1931

31

Aid to Revenue Continuance

Repealed by 1945/36

1936

32

Aid to Revenue Continuance

Repealed by 1945/36

1941

33

Aid to Revenue Continuance

Repealed by 1945/36

1943

34

Fish Protection

Amended 1916/3

35

Fish Protection (No 2)

Amended 1916/3

1945

36

Aid to Revenue

Repealed by 1956/52

1949

37

Cinematograph

Repealed by 1979/45

38

Traders’ Hours of Business

Amended 1916/2

1950

39

Curfew

Repealed by 1950/40

40

Curfew

Repealed by 1968/52

41

Motor Vehicles

Repealed by 1965/30

2Disallowed by the Governor-General pursuant to the Cook Islands Act 1915 (NZ), s 88, by notice published in the New

Zealand Gazette 27 September 1923, 2516.

xxxii

Chronological Table of Statutes

42

Bicycle Traffic

Repealed by 1965/30

43

Methylated Spirits

Repealed by 1965/24

44

Mosquito Control

Repealed by 1965/24

1955

45

Copra

Amended 1916/1

46

Contagious and Infectious Diseases

Repealed by 1965/24

47

Manufacture and Sale of Food

Repealed by 1965/24

1956

48

Permit

Amended 1927/29

49

Motor Vehicles

Amended 1950/44

50

Livestock

Repealed by 1967/44

51

Bicycle Traffic

Amended 1950/42

52

Aid to Revenue

Repealed by 1965/25

53

Manufacture and Sale of Food

Amended 1955/47

1958

54

Public Holidays

Repealed by 1961/11

55

Traders’ Hours of Business

Repealed by 1965/27

56

Fireworks

57

Dog Registration

Amended 1916/5

58

Aid to Elderly People

Repealed by 1965/25

1959

59

Building Permits

Repealed by 1992/165

60

Motor Vehicles

Amended 1950/41

1

Public Revenues

2

Appropriation

Repealed by 1959/5

3

Public Entertainments

Repealed by 1960/8

4

Building Permits

Amended 1959/59

5

Appropriation

Expired

1960

6

Electric Power Supply

7

Appropriation

Expired

8

Public Entertainments

Repealed by 1979/45

1961

9

Income Tax

10

Aid to Revenue

Amended 1957/52

11

Public Holidays

Repealed by 2004/269

12

Appropriation

Expired

1962

13

Liquor Control

Repealed by 1975/2

14

Appropriation

Expired

14A

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

xxxiii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

15

Purchase Tax

Repealed by 1964/21

16

Export Duty

Repealed by 1971/71

1963

17

(Bill not passed)

18

Planting of Land

Repealed by 2004/270

19

Appropriation

Expired

19A

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

1964

20

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

21

Manufactured Goods Tax

22

Appropriation

Expired

23

Inquest

1965

24

Public Health

25

Aid to Revenue Tax

Repealed by 1984/83

26

Appropriation

Expired

27

Hours of Business

Repealed by 1997/216

28

Immigration

Repealed by 1985/106

29

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

30

Transport

31

Cinematograph

Amended 1949/37

32

Fish Protection

Repealed by 1995/199

1966

33

Assembly

34

Civil List

Repealed by 1968/51

35

Dogs

36

Development

Repealed by 1984/94

37

Appropriation

Expired

38

Development

Amended 1966/69

39

Dogs

Amended 1966/35

1967

40

Regulations

Repealed by 2004/269

41

Village Councils

42

Immigration

Amended 1965/28

43

Debt Limitation

Repealed by 1971/65

44

Impounding

Repealed by 1998/233

45

Aid to Revenue Tax

Amended 1965/25

46

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

47

Manufactured Goods Tax

Amended 1964/21

48

Appropriation

Expired

xxxiv

Chronological Table of Statutes

1968

49

Appropriation

Expired

50

Commissions of Inquiry

51

Civil List

Repealed by 1972/79

52

General Laws

53

Wreck and Salvage

1969

54

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

55

Departure

Repealed by 1985/106

56

Appropriation

Expired

57

Land

58

Manufactured Goods Tax

Amended 1964/21

59

Development

Amended 1966/36

60

Copra

Repealed by 2006/279

1970

61

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

62

Tourist Board

Repealed by 1995/200

63

Appropriation

Expired

1971

64

Business Licences

Repealed by 1997/216

65

Credit Restriction

Repealed by 2004/270

66

Housing

Repealed by 1993/189

67

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

68

Census

69

Manufactured Goods Tax

Amended 1964/21

70

Appropriation

Expired

71

Export Duty Repeal

Spent

72

Copra

Amended 1969/60

1972

73

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

74

Wildlife

75

Appropriation

Expired

76

Copra

Amended 1969/60

77

Race Relations

78

Appropriation

Expired

79

Civil List Repeal

Spent

80

Appropriation

Expired

1973

81

Appropriation Order

Expired

82

Aviation Crimes

83

Appropriation

Expired

xxxv

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1974

84

Appropriation

Expired

85

Referendum

Spent

86

Appropriation

Expired

87

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1985/102

88

(Bill not passed)

89

Public Revenues

Amended 1959/1

90

Polynesian Airlines Shareholding

Repealed by 2004/270

91

Airlines Agency Corporation

Repealed by 1996/212

92

Hurricane Housing Forgiveness of Debt

Spent

93

Animal Importation

Repealed by 1984/99

1

Honey Company Dissolution

Spent

1975

2

Liquor

3

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

4

Arms

5

Price Control on Imported Goods for Resale

in Niue

6

Civil List

Repealed by 1975/17

7

Niue Assembly

Amended 1966/33

8

Aid to Revenue Tax

Repealed by 1984/83

9

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

10

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

11

Housing

Repealed by 1993/189

12

Appropriation

Expired

13

Inquest

Amended 1964/23

14

Public Holidays

Amended 1961/11

15

Aid to Revenue Tax

Repealed by 1984/83

16

Niue Flag

17

Civil List

Repealed by 1975/18

18

Civil List

Repealed by 1980/65

19

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1985/102

1976

20

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

21

Assembly Census

Amended 1971/68

22

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1985/102

23

Appropriation

Expired

24

Transport

Amended 1965/30

25

Civil List

Repealed by 1980/65

26

Atomic Energy

Amended 1945/41 (NZ)

1977

27

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

28

Constitutional Polls

29

Territorial Sea and Fishing Zone

Repealed by 1978/38

xxxvi

Chronological Table of Statutes

30

Mining

31

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

32

Appropriation

Expired

33

Transport

Amended 1965/30

34

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1985/102

35

Civil List

Repealed by 1980/65

1978

36

Niue Certification Authority

37

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

38

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone

Repealed by 1997/220

39

Aid to Revenue Tax

Repealed by 1984/83

40

Appropriation

Expired

41

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

42

Civil List

Repealed by 1975/18

1979

43

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

44

Appropriation

Expired

45

Film and Public Entertainment

46

Appropriation

Expired

47

Civil List

Repealed by 1975/18

48

Pensions and Benefits

Amended 1974/87

49

New Zealand Laws

50

Air Travel Tax

Repealed by 1996/212

51

Public Emergency

1980

52

Appropriation

Expired

53

Liquor

Amended 1975/2

54

Sunday Fishing Prohibition

Repealed by 1995/199

55

Public Service Savings and Loan Society

56

Government Loans

57

Appropriation (No 2)

Expired

58

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

59

Niue

Amended 1966/38(NZ)

60

Housing

Repealed by 1993/189

61

National Disaster Relief Fund

62

Civil List

Repealed by 1980/65

63

Mosquito Control

64

Public Health

Amended 1965/24

65

Civil List

Repealed by 1997/228

66

Safety at Sea

Repealed by 1995/199

1981

67

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

68

Appropriation

Expired

xxxvii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

69

New Zealand Representative

70

Food Control

71

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1985/102

72

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

73

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

1982

74

Credit Restriction

Amended 1971/65

75

Appropriation

Expired

76

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

77

Customs Tariff

78

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1985/102

79

Statutes

Spent

80

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

81

Constitutional Provisions

Repealed by 2004/270

1983

82

Development Fund

Repealed by 1993/189

83

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

84

Appropriation

Expired

85

Air Travel Tax

Amended 1980/50

86 Crimes against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages

87

Appropriation (No 2)

Expired

88

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1985/102

89

Appropriation (No 3)

Expired

1984

90

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone

Amended 1978/38

91

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

92

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

93

Development Fund

Amended 1983/82

94

Niue Development Board Dissolution

Spent

95

Film and Public Entertainment

Amended 1979/45

96

Assembly Members Superannuation

97

Appropriation

Expired

98

Niue (No 2)

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

99

Agriculture Quarantine

100

Appropriation

Expired

1985

101

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

102

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1991/157

103

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

104

Appropriation

Expired

105

Fish Protection

Amended 1916/3

106

Entry, Residence and Departure

xxxviii

Chronological Table of Statutes

107

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

108

Civil List Amendment (No 2)

Amended 1980/65

1986

109

Niue Cultural Council

110

Appropriation

Expired

111

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

112

Appropriations (No 2)

Expired

113

Pensions and Benefits

Amended 1985/102

114

Civil List (No 2)

Amended 1980/65

115

Banking

116

(Bill not passed)

117

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

118

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

1987

119

Appropriation

Expired

120

Decimal Currency

Amended 1964/27 (NZ)

121

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

122

Credit Restriction

Amended 1971/65

123

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone

Amended 1978/38

1988

124

Unauthorised Expenditure

Spent

125

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

126

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

127

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

128

Appropriation

Expired

129

Niue Customs Tariff

Amended 1982/77

1989

130

Education

131

Communications

132

Broadcasting

133

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

134

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

135

Supplementary Appropriation

Expired

136

Agriculture Quarantine

Amended 1984/99

137

Appropriation

Expired

138

Public Revenues

Amended 1959/1

139

Public Revenues (Write Offs)

Spent

140

(Bill not passed)

141

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

142

Entry, Residence and Departure

Amended 1985/106

xxxix

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1990

143

Supplementary Appropriation

Spent

144

Public Revenues

Amended 1959/1

145

146

Public Revenues (Validation of

Unappropriated Expenditure)

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Spent

Expired

147

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

148

Transport

Amended 1965/30

149

Transport (No 2)

Amended 1965/30

1991

150

Liquor

Amended 1975/2

151

Development Fund

Amended 1983/82

152

Price Control of Imported Goods

Amended 1795/5

153

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

154

Reprint of Statutes

155

156

Appropriations (Validation of Unauthorised

Expenditure)

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

Expired

157

Pensions and Benefits

158

Pesticides

159

Public Reserves

Amended 1959/1

1992

160

Niue Fish Protection

Repealed by 1995/199

161

Constitutional Polls

Amended 1977/28

162

Constitutional (No 1)

Amended 1974/42 (NZ)

163

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

164

Development Investment

165

Building Code

166

Archives

167

168

Appropriation (Validation of Unappropriated

Expenditure)

Niue Assembly

Expired

Amended 1966/30

169

Film and Public Entertainment

Amended 1979/45

170

International Air Services Licensing

Repealed by 1992/171

171

Air Services Licensing

Repealed by 2004/270

1993

172

Air Travel Tax

Amended 1980/50

173

Aviation Crimes

Amended 1973/82

174

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

175

176

Appropriation (Validation of

Unappropriated Expenditure)

Civil List

Expired

Amended 1980/65

xl

Chronological Table of Statutes

1994

177

Niue Bank

178

Off-Shore Insurance

Repealed 2006/275

179

Off-Shore Banking

Repealed by 1997/227

180

Partnership

Amended 1908/139 (NZ)

181

Niue Development Bonds

182

Trusts

183

Trustee Companies

184

International Business Companies

185

Off-Shore Centre (Miscellaneous Provisions)

Repealed by 2006/275

186

Public Notaries

Repealed by 1998/236

187

International Business Companies

Amended 1994/184

188

Off-Shore Centre (Miscellaneous Provisions)

Amended 1994/185

189

Niue Development Bank

190

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

191

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

192

Supplementary Appropriation

Spent

193

194

Off-Shore Centre (Miscellaneous Provisions)

(No 2)

Niue Development Bonds Amendment and

Amended 1994/185

Amended 1994/181

195

Ancillary Provisions

Off-Shore Insurance

Amended 1994/178

196

Off-Shore Banking

Amended 1994/179

1995

197

198

Appropriation (Validation of Unappropriated

Expenditure)

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

Expired

199

Domestic Fishing

200

Tourist Authority

201

Entry, Residence and Departure

Amended 1985/106

202

Pensions and Benefits

Amended 1985/102

203

Child Allowance

1996

204

Supplementary Appropriation

205

Civil List

Amended 1980/65

206

Niue Philatelic and Numismatic

207

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

208

Niue Development Bank

Amended 1994/189

209

Water Resources

210

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

211

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

212

Departure Tax

213

Niue Transport

Amended 1965/30

214

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

215

International Business Companies

Amended 1994/184

xli

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1997

216

Business Licence

217

Public Revenues (Write Off)

Spent

218

Supplementary Appropriation

Spent

219

Niue (No 2)

Amended 1968/132 (NZ)

220

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone

221

Niue Transport

Amended 1965/30

222

223

Appropriation (Validation of Unappropriated

Expenditure)

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

Expired

224

Niue Tourist Authority

Amended 1995/200

225

Broadcasting

Amended 1989/132

226

Liquor

Amended 1975/2

227

International Banking

Repealed by 2002/258

228

Civil List

Repealed by 1998/230

229

Education

Amended 1989/130

1998

230

Civil List

Repealed by 1999/248

231

Pig Control

232

Niue (Animals)

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

233

Niue Island Impounding (Repean( �/p>

Spent

234

Arms

Amended 1975/4

235

International Business Companies

Amended 1994/184

236

Public Notaries

237

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

238

Income Tax

Amended 1969/9

239

Liquor

Amended 1975/2

240

241

Appropriation (Validation of Unappropriated

Expenditure)

International Business Companies

Expired

Amended 1994/184

242

(No 2)

Extradition

Amended 1965/44 (NZ)

243

Misuse of Drugs

244

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters

245

Proceeds of Crime

1999

246

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

247

Income Tax

Amended 1961/9

248

Civil List

249

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

250

Civil Aviation

Amended 1973/82

2000

251

Communications

Amended 1989/131

252

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

253

Financial Transactions Reporting

Repealed by 2006/278

xlii

Chronological Table of Statutes

2001

254

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

255

Civil List

Amended 1999/248

256

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 2004/271

257

United Nations

Amended 1946/7 (NZ)

2002

258

International Banking Repeal

Spent

259

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

2003

260

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

261

262

Appropriation (Validation of Unappropriated

Expenditure)

Niue Philatelic and Numismatic

Expired

Amended 1996/206

263

Niue Tourist Authority

Amended 1995/200

264

Environment

2004

265

Civil List

Amended 1999/248

266

Niue Trust Fund

267

Niue Island General Laws

Amended 1968/52

268

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

Expired

269

Interpretation

270

271

Legislation (Correction of Errors and Minor

Amendments)

Pensions and Benefits

Spent

Amended 1991/157

272

Child Allowance

Amended 1995/203

2005

273

Niue

Amended 1966/38 (NZ)

274

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

2006

275

Companies

276

Mutual Assistance

Amended 1998/244

277

Appropriation (Annuan( �/p>

278

Financial Transactions Reporting

279

Minor Amendments

Spent

280 Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crime

281 Territorial Sea Amended 1997/220

xliii

Niue Laws 2006 Voll

xliv

TABLE OF SUBSIDIARY LEGISLATION IN FORCE

This table lists the subsidiary legislation in force in Niue as at December 2006. Unless otherwise indicated by ‘G’, ‘(NZ)’, or ‘SR’, references are to Niue statutes

and subsidiary legislation. ‘G 1970, III, 2318’ indicates the New Zealand Gazette,

1970, vol III, p 2318.

EMPOWERING INSTRUMENT

Title Main Instrument Amendments

CONSTITUTION OF NIUE

Niue Assembly Standing Orders 1998 2004

Public Service Regulations 2004/4

AGRICULTURE QUARANTINE ACT 1985

Agricultural Quarantine (Prevention of Animal 1991/4

Disease) Regulations

Agricultural Quarantine Phytosanitary 1993/1

Certificates (Fees) Regulations

Animal Quarantine (Disease Control) 1991/2

Regulations

Animal Quarantine (Fees) Regulations 1991/3

Plant Quarantine Regulations 1985

ARMS ACT 1974

Arms Registration (Fees) Regulations 2005/1

BROADCASTING ACT 1989

Broadcasting Regulations 1989/1

BUILDING CODE ACT 1992

National Building Code 1990

BUSINESS LICENCE ACT 1997

Business Licence Regulations 1997/5

xlv

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

CHATTELS TRANSFER ACT 1924

Chattels Transfer (Customary Hire Purchase) G 1925, II, 1517

Orders1 G 1925, III, 3055

G 1925, III, 3353

G 1926, II, 1805

G 1928, II, 2465

G 1930, II, 1509

G 1933, III, 2734

G 1935, II, 2273

SR 1938/49

SR 1940/311

SR 1950/68

SR 1953/45

SR 1954/78

SR 1955/148

SR 1956/146

SR 1957/33

SR 1960/85

SR 1962/7

SR 1962/47

SR 1965/26

SR 1968/87

SR 1969/110

SR 1969/253

Chattels Transfer Fees Regulations

SR 1967/270

CHILD ALLOWANCE ACT 1995

Child Allowance (Fees) Regulations

2004/3

CIVIL AVIATION ACT 1999

Civil Aviation Rules

1999/250/s52

COMMUNICATIONS ACT 1989

Radio Regulations

SR 1972/128

Telephone Regulations

SR 1968/25

CUSTOMS ACT 1966

Customs Regulations

SR 1968/169

SR 1969/196

SR 1970/189

SR 1970/241

SR 1971/258

SR 1972/238

SR 1973/66

SR 1974/154

1Seventh Schedule of the Chattels Transfer Act 1924 (NZ) incorporates all Orders made up until this consolidation.

xlvi

Chronological Table of Summary Legislation

Export Licences Regulations

Export Prohibition Regulations

Import Prohibition (Insecticides) Order

Import Prohibition (Offensive Weapons)

SR 1966/90

SR 1953/179

SR 1964/188

SR 1972/223

SR 1972/239

SR 1973/175

Order

Niue Port of Entry Order 1995

SR 1960/129

1974/80 (NZ)

1995/4

Port and Service Tax Regulations

SR 1952/177

CUSTOMS TARIFF ACT 1982

Customs Tariff Regulations

1988/2

1996/2

2006/1

Customs Tariff (Cigarettes and Tobacco) Regulations

1991/5

Customs Tariff (General Amendments) Regulations

1996/2

1997/3

DEPARTURE TAX ACT 1996

Departure Travel Tax Regulations

2002/1

DIPLOMATIC PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES ACT 1968 (NZ)

Diplomatic Privileges Consular Immunities

Regulations

SR 1969/136

1974/43 (NZ)

Diplomatic Immunities (Western Samoan

SR 1967/110

1974/43 (NZ)

Trade and Development Commissioner) Order

Diplomatic Privileges (Commonwealth SR 1973/99

Secretariat) Order

Diplomatic Privileges (Customs SR 1963/69

Co-operation) Council) Order

Diplomatic Privileges (FAO) Order SR 1959/52 SR 1961/14

SR 1967/96

Diplomatic Privileges (IAEA) Order SR 1960/162

xlvii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Diplomatic Privileges (ICAO) Order

SR 1959/53

Diplomatic Privileges (ICJ) Order

SR 1959/61

Diplomatic Privileges (ILO) Order

SR 1959/54

Diplomatic Privileges (IMCO) Order

SR 1960/141

SR 1961/67

SR 1969/66

Diplomatic Privileges (INTELSAT) Order

SR 1972/10

Diplomatic Privileges (ITU) Order

SR 1959/55

Diplomatic Privileges (New Zealand-United

States Educational Foundation) Order

SR 1970/45

Diplomatic Privileges (SEATO) Order

SR 1961/18

Diplomatic Privileges (South Pacific Bureau for Economic Cooperation) Order

SR 1973/34

Diplomatic Privileges (South Pacific

Commission) Order

SR 1959/56

Diplomatic Privileges (UNESCO) Order

SR 1959/57

Diplomatic Privileges (United Nations) Order SR 1959/51

SR 1965/18

Diplomatic Privileges (UPU) Order

SR 1959/58

Diplomatic Privileges (WHO) Order

SR 1959/59

SR 1961/66

Diplomatic Privileges (WMO) Order

SR 1959/60

DOGS ACT 1966

Dog Registration (Fees) Regulations

2005/2

DOMESTIC FISHING ACT 1995

Domestic Fishing Regulations

1996/1

ENTRY, RESIDENCE AND DEPARTURE TAX ACT 1985

Entry, Residence and Departure Regulations 1997/2

ENVIRONMENT ACT

Biosafety (Genetically Modified Organisms) 2006/4

Regulations

xlviii

Chronological Table of Summary Legislation

EXTRADITION ACT 1965

Extradition and Fugitive Offenders Orders3

Albania

G 1927, III, 2874

G 1928, II,1433

Argentina

G 1894, I, 669

Australia

G 1926, I, 77

Austria

G 1874, 416

G 1902, II,2633

G 1935, III, 2845

Belgium

G 1902, I, 1158

G 1907, II, 2924

G 1911, II, 3406

Bolivia

G 1899, I, 11

Brazil

G 1874, 175

British Solomon Islands

G 1926, I, 77

Chile

G 1898, II, 1669

Colombia

G 1890, I, 351

Cuba

G 1905, II, 1898

Czechoslovakia

G 1927, I, 359

G 1927, III, 2915

Ecuador

G 1886, II, 1248

Estonia

G 1926, II, 2602

G 1927, II, 1455

Fiji

G 1926, I, 77

Finland

G 1925, II, 2176

G 1925, III, 3411

France

G 1878, II, 1137

G 1910, I, 749

German Colonies

G 1895, I, 772

Germany

G 1872, 739

G 1920, III, 3059

Gilbert and Ellice Islands

(Kiribati and Tuvalu)

G 1926, I, 77

3These Orders were made under the Extradition Act 1965 (NZ) before 19 October 1974. In respect of possible extradition involving any of the countries listed it is necessary to check both whether the relevant treaty applies to Niue and whether extradition is available in respect of the particular offence.

xlix

Greece

Niue Laws 2006

Vol 1

G 1912, I, 1418

Guatemala

G 1887, II, 933

G 1914, II, 4082

Hungary

G 1874, 416

G 1902, II, 2633

G 1938, I, 902

SR 1940/10

Iceland

G 1873, 575

SR 1940/69

India

G 1904, II, 1967

Iraq

G 1934, III, 3358

Italy

G 1873, 445, 507

Latvia

G 1926, I, 429, 610

Liberia

G 1894, I, 825

Lithuania

G 1927, II, 2537

G 1928, II, 2485

Luxembourg

G 1881, I, 863

Mexico

G 1889, II, 810

Monaco

G 1892, II, 1215

Nauru

G 1926, I, 77

Netherlands

G 1899, I, 762

New Zealand

G 1926, I, 77

SR 1941/185

Nicaragua

G 1906, II, 2099

Norway

G 1874, I, 8

G 1907, II, 2995,

3138

Panama

G 1907, II, 3136

Papua

G 1926, I, 77

Paraguay

G 1911, II, 3158

Peru

G 1907, II, 2324

l

Chronological Table of Summary Legislation

Poland

G 1935, III, 3365

Portugal

G 1894, I, 822

G 1933, II, 2081

G 1933, III, 2484

Romania

G 1894, II, 1264

Russia

G 1887, I, 720

Salvador

G 1883, I, 352

San Marino

G 1900, II, 1302

Serbia

G 1901, II, 2036

Spain

G 1879, I, 324

G 1889, II, 939, 947

Sweden

G 1874, 8

G 1907, II, 3138

Switzerland

G 1881, I, 412

G 1905, II, 1996

G 1936, I, 278

Thailand

G 1912, I, 193

Tonga

G 1883, I, 352

Tunis

G 1890, II, 876

USA

SR 1970/240

Uruguay

G 1885, I, 724

G 1892, I, 522

Western Samoa

G 1921, I, 92

G 1926, I, 77

FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT ACT 1979

Film and Public Entertainment (Fees) 2005/3

Regulations

GENERAL LAWS ACT 1968

Maritime Security Regulations

2004/2

INCORPORATED SOCIETIES ACT 1908

Incorporated Societies Regulations

SR 1938/34

SR 1954/41

SR 1957/254

SR 1967/265

li

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

LIQUOR ACT 1975

Liquor (Breweries) Regulations

1992/2

MISUSE OF DRUGS ACT 1975

Misuse of Drugs Regulations4

SR 1977/37

SR 1977/135

NIUE ACT 1966

Airport Charges Regulations

1992/1

Audit Regulations

SR 1970/103

1974/43 (NZ)

Births and Deaths Registration

1984

1995/5

Regulations

Co-operative Societies Regulations

SR 1953/106

SR 1957/53

G 1955, II, 1346

Dental Regulations

SR 1970/104

1974/43 (NZ)

Gaming (Fees) Regulations

2005/4

High Court Rules 1916

SR 1962/204

1962/72

(Reprint)

1975/4

1975/5

1991/8

Land Court Rules

SR 1969/126

SR 1969/205

1974/43 (NZ)

1995/6

2005/273

Land Registration Regulations

SR 1969/169

SR 1969/205

SR 1972/52

2005/273

Marine Pollution Act 1974

SR 1972/143

1974/14 (NZ)

SR 1974/142

Oil in Navigable Waters (Prohibited Sea

SR 1971/103

1972/4 (NZ)

Areas)Regulations

Oil in Navigable Waters (Records, Transfer SR 1971/104

1972/4 (NZ)

and Enforcement of Convention Order)

Regulations

4See Cabinet Minutes 204 of 1976 and 70 to 1977.

lii

Chronological Table of Summary Legislation

Oil in Navigable Waters (Ships’ SR 1971/105 1972/4 (NZ) Equipment) Regulations

Marriage Regulations SR 1970/249

Penal Manual 2006/3

Sea Carriage of Goods Act 1940 1940/31 (NZ) SR 1946/19 (in part only) [s 14] 1961/68 (NZ)

1962/100(NZ)

1964/27(NZ)

1968/17(NZ)

2004/270

2006/279

NIUE BANK ACT 1994

Niue Bank Regulations 1994/1

PARTNERSHIP ACT 1908

Partnership Amendment Fees Regulations 1994/4

PARTNERSHIP APPLICATION ACT 1994

Partnership Amendment Forms Regulations 1995/2

PENSIONS AND BENEFITS ACT 1991

Pensions and Benefits Regulations 1998/7

PUBLIC HEALTH ACT 1965

International Sanitary Regulations 1951

Public Health (Notifiable Diseases) Notice 1991/6

PUBLIC REVENUES ACT 1959

Niue Treasury Rules 1960 1961

TERRITORIAL SEA AND EXCLUSIVE ECONOMIC ZONE ACT 1997

Niue Whale Sanctuary Regulations 2003/1

TRANSPORT ACT 1965

Transport (Fees) Regulations 2005/5

TRUSTEE ACT 1956

Trustees’ Commission Rules SR 1961/81

TRUSTEE COMPANIES ACT 1994

Trustee Companies Regulations 1994/5

liii

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

UNITED NATIONS ACT 1946

United Nations Sanctions (Terrorism

Suppression and Afghanistan Measures)

Regulations

2004/5

VISITING FORCES ACT 1939 (NZ) Visiting Forces (Commonwealth Deserters and Absentees) Order

SR 1969/81

Visiting Forces Order

SR 1966/33

Visiting Forces (Penal Arrangement) Order

SR 1963/61

Visiting Forces (Relative Ranks) Regulations SR 1971/223

WILDLIFE ACT 1972

Wildlife Protected Species Notice 1991/9

liv

CHRONOLOGICAL TABLE OF SUBSIDIARY LEGISLATION

This table lists the subsidiary legislation made in Niue from 1990 to 1 December 2006.


Year

No.

In Force

Title

Status

1990

1

01.12.90

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1992/4

1991

1

01.07.91

Niue (Gambling)

Repealed by 2005/4

2

01.09.91

Animal Quarantine (Disease Contron( �/p>

3

01.09.91

Animal Quarantine (Fees)

4

01.09.91

Agriculture Quarantine (Prevention of

Animal Disease)

5

03.09.91

Niue Customs Tariff (Cigarettes and

Tobacco)

6

01.10.91

Public Health (Notifiable Diseases)

7

02.03.92

Transport (Annual Licence Fees)

Repealed by 2005/5

8

01.12.91

Rules of the High Court

9

19.11.91

Wildlife Protected Species

1992

1

01.04.92

Niue Airport Charges

2

22.09.92

Liquor (Breweries)

3

20.08.92

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1993/2

1993

1

01.07.93

Agricultural Quarantine Phytosanitary

Certificate (Fees)

2

01.11.93

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1998/2

1994

1

08.06.94

Niue Bank

2

08.06.94

Off-Shore Banking

Repealed by Act 1997/227

3

08.06.94

Off-Shore Insurance

Repealed by Act 2006/275

4

08.06.94

Partnership Amendment Fees

5

08.06.94

Trustee Companies

lv

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

1995

1

01.07.95

Off-Shore Banking

Repealed by Act 1997/227

2

01.07.95

Partnership Amendment Forms

3

19.09.95

Niue Act Revocations

Spent

4

19.09.95

Customs

Spent

5

01.07.95

Births and Deaths

Amended 1984

6

01.07.95

High Court of Niue Land Division

(Fees)

1996

1

05.03.96

Domestic Fishing

2

01.01.97

Niue Customs Tariff (General

Amended by 1997/3

Amendments)

1997

1

14.01.97

Departure Travel Tax

Repealed by 2002/1

2

14.01.97

Entry, Residence and Departure

3

14.01.97

Niue Customs Tariff (General

Amendments)

4

05.12.97

Niue Customs (Temporary Waiver)

Spent

5

04.01.97

Business Licence

1998

1

31.12.98

Child Allowance

Repealed by 1998/6

2

01.07.98

Pensions and Benefits

Repealed by 1998/7

3

20.01.98

International Banking (Fees)

4

01.07.98

Niue Customs (Temporary Waiver)

Spent

5

03.11.98

Niue Customs Tariff (Miscellaneous

Transactions and Commodities)

6

01.01.99

Child Allowance (No 1)

Repealed by 2004/3

7

13.10.98

Pensions and Benefits

1999

1

15.06.99

Niue Customs (Temporary Waiver)

Spent

2002

1

15.10.02

Departure Travel Tax

2003

1

14.05.02

Niue Whale Sanctuary

2004

1

08.01.04

Public Emergency

Spent

2

01.07.04

Maritime Security

3

01.07.04

Child Allowance (Fees)

4

15.07.04

Public Service

lvi

Chronological Table of Summary Legislation

5

23.11.04

UN Sanctions (Terrorism Suppression

and Afghanistan Measures)

2005

1

24.06.03

Arms Registration (Fees)

2

24.06.03

Dogs (Fees)

3

24.06.03

Film and Public Entertainment

4

24.06.03

Gaming (Fees)

5

24.06.03

Transport (Fees)

2006

1

01.01.05

Customs Tariff

2

01.08.06

Companies Act Commencement

Spent

3

26.09.06

Penal Manual

4

04.07.06

Biosafety

lvii

lviii Niue Laws 2006 Voll

1

THE CONSTITUTION OF NIUE

The Making of Laws

28 Power to make laws

29 Introduction of Bills, etc, into Niue

Assembly

30 Restrictions with regard to financial

measures

31 [Repealed]

32 Special provisions with regard to measures

affecting the Niue Public Service

33 Special provisions with regard to measures

affecting Niuean land

34 When Bills become law

35 Power of the Niue Assembly to repeal or

amend this Constitution

36 New Zealand Parliament not to legislate for

Niue, and New Zealand subordinate

legislation not to apply to Niue, except with

consent

The Seal of Niue

15 Seal of Niue

PART II

THE LEGISLATIVE GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

The Niue Assembly

16 Niue Assembly

17 Nationality and residential qualifications of

electors and candidates

18 Public servants may become candidates or

be elected

19 Members disqualified from becoming

public servants or interested in

Government contracts

20 Speaker of Niue Assembly

21 Members to take Oath of Allegiance

22 Procedure of Niue Assembly

23 Languages

24 Privileges of Niue Assembly and its

members

25 Remuneration of Premier, other Ministers,

other members of the Niue Assembly, and

the Speaker

26 Dissolution of the Niue Assembly

27 Clerk of the Niue Assembly

PART III THE JUDICIARY

The High Court of Niue

37 High Court established

38 Jurisdiction of Divisions of the High Court

39 Judges of the High Court

40 Acting Chief Justice of the High Court

41 Temporary Judges

Appointment, Tenure of Office and Salaries of Judges

42 Appointment of Judges

43 Tenure of office of Judges

44 Salaries of Judges

45 Removal of Judges from office

Commissioners of the High Court

46 Commissioners of the High Court

47 Temporary Commissioners

48 Jurisdiction of Commissioners of the High

Court

49 Remuneration of Commissioners of the

High Court

50 Removal of Commissioners from office

Justices of the Peace

51 Justices of the Peace

2 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Court of Appeal

52 Court of Appeal established

53 Number of Judges

54 Judges not to sit on appeals from own

decision

55 Determination of Court of Appeal

55A Jurisdiction of Court of Appeal

55B Transmission of order of Court of Appeal

Oath of Allegiance and Judicial Oath

55C Oath of Allegiance and Judicial Oath

PART IV

THE PUBLIC REVENUES OF NIUE

56 Legislative control of public revenue and

expenditure

57 Niue Government Account

58 Annual estimates and appropriations

59 Cabinet to supervise expenditure

60 Audit

PART V

HEALTH, EDUCATION AND OTHER SOCIAL SERVICES

61 Health, education, and other social services

PART VI

THE NIUE PUBLIC SERVICE

62 Niue Public Service

63 Secretary to the Government

Niue Public Service Commission

64 Niue Public Service Commission

65 Acting members of Commission

66 Procedure of Commission

67 Delegation of powers

Management of Niue Public Service

68 Functions and powers of Commission

69 Appointments to Niue Public Service

Reports and Recommendations to Assembly

70 Commission to make certain reports and

recommendations to Assembly

PART VII TRANSITIONAL PROVISIONS

71 Existing law to continue

72-80 [Spent]

81 Seal of Niue

PART VIII INTERPRETATION

82 Interpretation


3

THE CONSTITUTION OF NIUE

PART I
THE EXECUTIVE GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

1 Executive authority vested in the Crown

The executive authority of Niue is vested in Her Majesty the Queen in right
of New Zealand, and the Governor-General of New Zealand is accordingly the
representative of Her Majesty the Queen in relation to Niue.

The Cabinet

2 Cabinet of Ministers of Niue

(1) There shall be a Cabinet of Ministers of Niue (hereinafter referred to as
the Cabinet) which shall consist of the Premier of Niue (who shall be a member of
the Niue Assembly) and 3 other members of the Niue Assembly.
(2) Subject to this Constitution, the executive authority of Niue may be
exercised on behalf of Her Majesty by the Cabinet, which shall have the general
direction and control of the executive government of Niue and shall have such
other functions and powers as are conferred on it by law.

3 Ministers to be collectively responsible

(1) The members of the Cabinet (hereinafter referred to as Ministers) shall
be collectively responsible to the Niue Assembly.
(2) Subject to Article 7 of this Constitution, the Ministers shall continue in
office until their successors are appointed pursuant to Article 5(2) of this
Constitution.

4 Premier of Niue

(1) There shall be a Premier of Niue, who shall be elected to that office by
an absolute majority of the members present and voting at a meeting of the Niue
Assembly.
(2) The Niue Assembly shall proceed to elect the Premier at the first meeting
of the Assembly after a general election and also in each of the following
circumstances –
(a) If the Premier ceases to be a member of the Assembly for any reason
other than the dissolution thereof; or
(b) If the Premier tenders his resignation by writing under his hand
addressed to the Speaker or is deemed to have tendered his
resignation pursuant to Article 6(3) or Article 7(3) of this
Constitution.

5 Appointment of Ministers after election of Premier

(1) As soon as practicable after his election to that office, the Premier elect
shall nominate to the Speaker, with their consent, 3 other members of the Niue
Assembly for appointment as Ministers.
(2) Upon receiving those nominations, the Speaker shall appoint as
Ministers the Premier elect and the members so nominated.
(3) Appointment under subclause (2) of this Article shall be made by the
Speaker by instrument under the Seal of Niue.
4 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(4) If the Premier elect has not within 7 days after but excluding the date of his election to that office submitted to the Speaker his nominations for appointments to the Cabinet pursuant to this Article, his election to that office shall have no effect, and, subject to Article 26(1)(d) of this Constitution, a meeting of the Niue Assembly shall be held as soon as practicable for the purpose of again electing a Premier.

6 Vote of confidence in Cabinet

(1) At any meeting of the Niue Assembly –
(a) The Premier, or another Minister acting on behalf of the Premier,
may give notice of his intention to move a vote of confidence in the
Cabinet, either generally or on any measure proposed by the Cabinet
for adoption by the Assembly;
(b) Any 4 or more members of the Assembly who are not Ministers
may give notice of their intention to move a vote of no confidence
in the Cabinet.
(2) Any motion of which notice is given under subclause (1) of this Article
shall be voted on at a meeting of the Niue Assembly held not earlier than 5 days
nor later than 10 days after but excluding the date of the giving of the notice.
(3) If the motion of confidence is lost, or, as the case may be, the motion of
no confidence is carried, the Premier shall be deemed to have tendered his
resignation from his office at the expiration of 5 days after but excluding the date
of the meeting of the Niue Assembly, unless before the expiration of that period
he requests the Speaker to dissolve the Assembly.

7 Vacation of office by Ministers

(1) Any Minister, other than the Premier, shall vacate his office if –
(a) His appointment to that office is revoked by the Speaker, acting on
the request of the Premier, by instrument under the Seal of Niue; or
(b) He ceases to be a member of the Niue Assembly for any reason
other than the dissolution thereof; or
(c) He resigns his office by writing under his hand delivered to the
Speaker.
(2) Within 7 days after the occurrence of any vacancy in the office of
Minister, other than the Premier, the Premier shall nominate to the Speaker, with
the consent of the member, a member of the Niue Assembly for appointment as a
Minister, and the Speaker shall by instrument under the Seal of Niue appoint the
member so nominated.
(3) If the Premier does not, within 7 days after but excluding the date of
the occurrence of a vacancy in the office of a Minister, other than the Premier,
nominate a Minister pursuant to subclause (2) of this Article, he shall be deemed
to have tendered his resignation from his office as Premier at the expiration of
that period of 7 days.

8 Temporary Ministers

(1) Whenever it appears to the Premier that any Minister will, by reason of
illness or absence from Niue, be unable to discharge his functions in Niue for a
period of 7 days or longer, the Premier shall nominate to the Speaker, with the
consent of the member, a member of the Niue Assembly for appointment as a
temporary Minister, and the Speaker shall, by instrument under the Seal of Niue,
appoint that member accordingly.

Constitution of Niue 5

(2) Every such temporary Minister shall be appointed in place of the Minister who is unable to discharge his functions in Niue, and, subject to subclause (3) of this Article, shall hold office, as if he had been appointed under Article 5 of this Constitution.
(3) Every such temporary Minister, unless he sooner vacates his office pursuant to Article 7 of this Constitution, shall remain in office until the Minister in whose place he is appointed is again able to discharge his functions in Niue.

9 Acting Premier

(1) Whenever, by reason of illness or absence from Niue, the Premier is
temporarily prevented from discharging his functions in Niue, the Speaker, acting
on the request of the Cabinet, may, by instrument under the Seal of Niue, appoint
another Minister to discharge the functions of Premier until such time as the
Premier is capable of again discharging his functions or has vacated his office.
(2) Where the Premier dies or tenders his resignation to the Speaker after a
dissolution of the Niue Assembly and before the appointment of the Ministers
after the general election following that dissolution, the Speaker, acting on the
request of the Cabinet, shall, by instrument under the Seal of Niue, appoint another
Minister to discharge the functions of Premier until the Ministers are appointed
after that general election.

10 Official oath

Every Minister shall, before assuming the functions of his office, take and
subscribe before the Speaker the following oath –
I,........., being chosen and accepted as Premier of Niue (or a Minister), swear by
Almighty God that I will to the best of my judgment, at all times when thereto
required, freely give my counsel and advice for the good management of the affairs
of Niue, and that I will not directly or indirectly reveal such matters as may be
debated in the Cabinet or any committee of the Cabinet and committed to my
secrecy, but that I will in all such things be a true and faithful Premier of Niue (or
Minister). So help me God.

11 Allocation of responsibilities to Ministers

(1) The Premier shall from time to time, by writing under his hand
countersigned by the Clerk of the Cabinet and published in the Niue Gazette, allocate
to any Minister (including himself) the primary responsibility for any Department
or function of Government, and may from time to time in like manner vary any
such allocation.
(2) The Premier shall have the primary responsibility for any Department
or function of Government in respect of which, for the time being, no allocation
under subclause (1) of this Article is in effect.

12 Meetings of Cabinet

(1) No business shall be transacted at any meeting of the Cabinet unless at
least 3 Ministers are present.
(2) The Cabinet shall not be disqualified for the transaction of business by
reason only that there is a vacancy among its members, or that, in any case where
Article 8 of this Constitution applies, no appointment has been made pursuant to
that Article. No proceedings of the Cabinet shall be questioned on the ground that
some person who acted as a Minister in relation to those proceedings was not
qualified so to act.
6 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) Notice of every meeting of the Cabinet and a copy of every paper to be considered at that meeting shall be given to each Minister, and to the Secretary to the Government.
(4) The Secretary to the Government shall have the right to attend any meeting of the Cabinet and to speak on any matter under consideration by the Cabinet, and he shall so attend if required to do so by the Premier.
(5) The decision of the Cabinet on any matter shall be taken only by the
Ministers present at a meeting of the Cabinet.
(6) Subject to this Article, the Cabinet shall regulate its own procedure in
such manner as it thinks fit.

13 Rules, other enactments, and decisions of Cabinet

Any rule or other enactment of the Cabinet shall have effect, and any other
decision of the Cabinet shall be duly authenticated, when that rule or other
enactment, or the record of that decision, has been signed by the Premier, whether
or not he was present at the meeting of the Cabinet at which the rule or other
enactment or decision was made, and by the Clerk of the Cabinet.

14 Clerk of the Cabinet

There shall be an officer of the Niue Public Service to be called the Clerk of
the Cabinet, who shall be responsible for arranging the business for, and keeping
the minutes of, meetings of the Cabinet, and for conveying decisions of the Cabinet
to the appropriate person or authority, and shall perform with respect to the Cabinet
such secretarial and other functions as may be required.

15 Seal of Niue

The Seal of Niue

(1) There shall be a Public Seal of Niue (in this Constitution referred to as the Seal of Niue), to be in such form or forms as the Cabinet from time to time approves.
(2) The Seal of Niue shall be in the custody of the Speaker.
(3) The Seal of Niue may be used by the Speaker for the authentication of
any public document in relation to the Government of Niue or for the execution
of any document required by law to be executed under the Seal of Niue.
(4) Judicial notice shall be taken of the Seal of Niue in all Courts.
PART II
THE LEGISLATIVE GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

The Niue Assembly

16 Niue Assembly

(1) There shall be in and for Niue a legislative Assembly to be called the
Niue Assembly.
(2) The Niue Assembly shall consist of –
(a) The Speaker; and
(b) Twenty members to be elected by secret ballot under a system of
universal suffrage in the following manner –
(i) Fourteen members, each of whom shall represent a village
constituency, shall be elected by the electors of that constituency;
(ii) Six members shall be elected by the persons qualified to be
electors of Niue voting on a common roll, which, for the purpose
of electing those members, shall comprise the rolls of the several
village constituencies.

Constitution of Niue 7

(3) Subject to this Article and to Articles 17, 18, 19, 24 and 25 of this Constitution, the boundaries of village constituencies, the qualifications and disqualification of electors and of candidates, the mode of electing members of the Niue Assembly, and the terms and conditions of their membership shall be as prescribed by law:
Provided that –
(a) There shall be 14 village constituencies; and
(b) Every person qualified to be an elector for the election of members
of the Niue Assembly shall be entitled to vote in one, and one only,
village constituency; and
(c) Any determination or redetermination of the boundaries of any
village constituency shall, so far as practicable, having due regard
to local community interest, be made in accordance with the
principle that the number of electors in that village constituency
should not be substantially greater or smaller than the number of
electors in any other village constituency.
(4) Unless the context otherwise requires, every reference in this
Constitution to a member of the Niue Assembly shall be construed as a reference
to a member elected pursuant to subclause (2)(b) of this Article, and shall, in any
case where the Assembly has been dissolved, be read as a reference to a person
who was a member of the Assembly immediately before that dissolution.

17 Nationality and residential qualifications of electors and candidates

(1) Without limiting the provisions of any law prescribing any additional
qualifications, a person shall be qualified to be an elector for the election of members
of the Niue Assembly, or to be a candidate at any such election, if, and only if, that
person –
(a) Is either –
(i) a New Zealand citizen; or
(ii) a Permanent Resident of Niue as defined by Act; and,
(b) Has at some period resided continuously in Niue for not less than
3 years; and
(c) Has been ordinarily resident in Niue throughout the period of 12
months immediately preceding an application for enrolment as an
elector or, as the case may be, nomination as a candidate.
(2) For the purposes of this Article, a person shall be deemed to be ordinarily
resident in Niue if, and only if –
(a) He is actually residing in Niue; or
(b) Having been actually resident in Niue with the intention of residing
there indefinitely, he is outside Niue but has, and has had ever since
he left Niue, an intention to return and reside there indefinitely:
Provided that any person who has been outside Niue continuously for any
period of more than 3 years shall be deemed not to have such an intention, unless
during the whole or substantially the whole period of that absence he was
undergoing a course of education or of technical training or instruction, or was in
the service of the Government of Niue.

18 Public servants may become candidates or be elected

(1) Employees of the Niue Public Service who become candidates for
election as members of the Niue Assembly shall be granted leave of absence for
the purposes of their candidature in accordance with such terms and conditions
as may be prescribed by law.
8 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) If any such employee is elected as a member of the Assembly, he shall, on being declared so elected, be deemed to have been granted leave of absence without salary from his employment in the Niue Public Service for the period during which he is a member.

19 Members disqualified from becoming public servants or interested in

Government contracts

The seat of any member of the Niue Assembly shall become vacant –
(a) If he becomes an employee of the Niue Public Service, or, being an
employee of that Service at the time of his election, he accepts paid
employment in that Service, or;
(b) If he otherwise becomes interested in the execution or enjoyment
of any contract under which any public money is payable, except
to such extent as may be permitted by law.

20 Speaker of Niue Assembly

(1) The Speaker of the Niue Assembly shall be elected to that office by an
absolute majority of the members present and voting at a meeting of the Niue
Assembly.
(2) Only a person who is qualified for election as a member of the Niue
Assembly may be elected as Speaker.
(3) If any person elected as Speaker is, at the time of that election, a member
of the Niue Assembly, he shall vacate his office as a member when he enters upon
the duties of the office of Speaker.
(4) The election of the Speaker shall take place, before the despatch of any
other business, at the first meeting of the Assembly after each general election,
and, at a meeting of the Assembly called for that purpose, as soon as possible after
any vacancy in the office of Speaker has occurred.
(5) Before a person who has been elected Speaker enters upon the duties
of his office, he shall take and subscribe before the Clerk of the Niue Assembly at
a meeting of the Assembly the Oath of Allegiance prescribed in Article 21 of this
Constitution, and the provisions of that Article shall apply with the necessary
modifications as if the references therein to a member were a reference to the
Speaker.
(6) The Speaker may resign his office by writing under his hand addressed
and delivered to the Clerk of the Niue Assembly, and shall vacate his office –
(a) On the entry into office of a new Speaker elected when the Assembly
first meets after a general election; or
(b) If he ceases to be qualified for election as a member of the Assembly;
or
(c) If he becomes a candidate at any election of a member or members
of the Assembly.
(7) If at any meeting of the Assembly the Speaker is absent or the office of
Speaker is vacant, the members of the Assembly present at that meeting shall
elect one of their number, not being a Minister, to preside over that meeting until
the Speaker is again present, or, as the case may be, until a Speaker has been
elected and has entered upon the duties of his office.
(8) If, at any time when the Assembly is not meeting, the Speaker is, by
reason of illness or absence from Niue, temporarily prevented from performing
his functions, or the office of Speaker is vacant, then, until the Assembly again
meets, or, as the case may be, the Speaker is again able to perform his functions,
those functions shall be performed by a member of the Assembly, not being a

Constitution of Niue 9

Minister, who has presided over a meeting of the Assembly pursuant to subclause (7) of this Article. If more than one member of the Assembly is so qualified and is available to perform the functions of the Speaker, those functions shall be performed by the member who most recently presided over a meeting of the Assembly, pursuant to that subclause.
(9) If it appears that no person is, for the time being, qualified and available
to perform the functions of the Speaker –
(a) A meeting of the Assembly shall be called as soon as possible, and
the Clerk of the Niue Assembly shall perform such of the functions
of the Speaker as are required to be performed for the purpose of
enabling that meeting to be held, and the provisions of Article 22(6)
of this Constitution shall not apply to that meeting; or
(b) In any case where the Assembly has been dissolved and the ensuing
general election has not taken place, a meeting of those persons
who were members of the Assembly immediately before its
dissolution shall be called as soon as possible for the purpose of
electing one of their number to perform the functions of the Speaker
until the Speaker is again able to perform his functions, or, as the
case may be, the new Assembly first meets; and the Clerk of the
Niue Assembly shall do everything necessary to ensure that the
meeting is called and to certify to the result of the election. The
person elected shall, for the purpose of subclauses (7) and (8) of
this Article, be deemed to be a person who has presided over a
meeting of the Assembly.
(10) Every document, including the certificate on any Bill, signed by the
Speaker in the performance of his functions shall be countersigned by the Clerk of
the Niue Assembly, and, where pursuant to this Article, any such document or
certificate is signed by a member performing the functions of the Speaker, it shall
be so stated on the document or in that certificate.

21 Members to take Oath of Allegiance

Except for the purpose of enabling this Article to be complied with and for
the election of a Speaker, no member of the Niue Assembly shall be permitted to
sit or vote therein until he has taken and subscribed the following oath before the
Speaker namely:
I,..........................., swear by Almighty God that I will be faithful and bear true
allegiance to Her (or His) Majesty [Specify the name of the reigning Sovereign, as thus:

Queen Elizabeth the Second, Her (or His) heirs and successors according to law, and

that I will justly and faithfully carry out my duties as member of the Niue Assembly.
So help me God.

22 Procedure of Niue Assembly

(1) The Niue Assembly shall meet at such places and at such times as the
Speaker, acting on the request of the Premier, from time to time appoints in that
behalf:
Provided that, if more than 6 weeks has elapsed since the time of the last meeting
of the Assembly, any 4 or more members of the Assembly who are not Ministers
may request the Speaker to appoint a place and time for a meeting of the Assembly,
and the Speaker shall appoint a place and time in that behalf, such time to be not
earlier than 5 days nor later than 10 days after but excluding the date of the making
of the request.
10 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) The Speaker shall preside at every meeting of the Niue Assembly at which he is present.
(3) Except where this Constitution otherwise provides, every question before the Niue Assembly shall be decided by a majority of the votes of the members present.
(4) Subject to any law requiring any member of the Assembly to refrain
from voting on any matter concerning a contract in whose execution and enjoyment
he is interested, every member present when any question is put to the Niue
Assembly shall vote thereon.
(5) The Speaker or other presiding officer shall not have a casting vote and
the Speaker shall not have a deliberative vote, but a member presiding in place of
the Speaker shall have a deliberative vote.
(6) Subject to Article 20(9)(a) of this Constitution, no business shall be
transacted at any meeting of the Niue Assembly if the number of members then
present, including any member presiding in place of the Speaker, is less than 10.
(7) The powers of the Niue Assembly shall not be affected by any vacancy
in its membership.
(8) No Bill shall be passed unless it has been read 3 times in the Assembly.
(9) Any Bill or other business before the Assembly at its dissolution shall
lapse.
(10) Subject to this Constitution, the Niue Assembly may from time to time
make Standing Orders for the regulation and orderly conduct of its proceedings and the despatch of business.

23 Languages

(1) The Speaker or any member of the Niue Assembly may speak in the
Assembly either in the Niuean language or in the English language:
Provided that the Clerk of the Niue Assembly shall, at the request of the
Speaker or of any member made through the Speaker, arrange for the remarks of
the Speaker or of any member to be translated into the English language or the
Niuean language, as the case may be.
(2) Every Bill introduced into the Niue Assembly and every Act shall be in
the Niuean language and also in the English language:
Provided that the Assembly may, by resolution, determine that any Bill or
Act shall be in the Niuean language or English language only.
(3) The records of proceedings in the Niue Assembly or in Committees
thereof shall be in the Niuean language, and such of those records as are specified
in the Standing Orders of the Assembly or as the Assembly may by resolution
determine shall also be in the English language.
(4) The Niuean version and the English version of this Constitution and,
subject to subclause (5) of this Article, the Niuean version and the English version
of any record of proceedings in the Niue Assembly or any Committee thereof and
of any enactment shall be equally authentic:
Provided that if in any case there is any apparent discrepancy between any
provision of the Niuean version and of the English version of this Constitution or
of any such record or of any enactment, then, in construing that provision, regard
shall be made to all the circumstances that tend to establish the true intent and
meaning of that provision.
(5) In the case of any record of proceedings in the Niue Assembly or any
Committee thereof the Assembly may by resolution determine, and in the case of
any enactment it may be expressly provided, that where there is any conflict
between the Niuean version and the English version of any such record or of any
such enactment, one version only, being either the Niuean version or the English
version, shall prevail.

Constitution of Niue 11

24 Privileges of Niue Assembly and its members

(1) The validity of any proceedings in the Niue Assembly or in any
Committee thereof, and the validity of any certificate duly given by the Speaker
under Article 34 or Article 35 of this Constitution shall not be questioned in any
Court.
(2) Neither the Speaker nor any member or officer of the Niue Assembly in whom powers are vested for the regulation of procedure or the conduct of business or the maintenance of order shall in relation to the exercise by him of any of those powers be subject to the jurisdiction of any Court.
(3) Neither the Speaker nor any member of the Niue Assembly nor any person entitled to speak therein shall be liable to any proceedings in any Court in respect of anything said or any vote given by him in the Assembly or in any Committee thereof.
(4) No person shall be liable to any proceedings in any Court in respect of the publication by or under the authority of the Niue Assembly of any report, paper, vote, or proceeding.
(5) Subject to this Article, the privileges of the Niue Assembly and of the Committees thereof and the privileges of members and the Speaker of the Assembly and of the persons entitled to speak therein may be determined by Act; and any such Act may define offences relating to breach of privilege or contempt of the Assembly, and may make provision for the trial and punishment of such offences by the High Court, but not otherwise.

25 Remuneration of Premier, other Ministers, other members of the Niue

Assembly, and the Speaker

(1) The Niue Public Service Commission may from time to time, and shall
when there is a general alteration of the levels of remuneration of employees of
the Niue Public Service, report and make recommendations to the Assembly as to
the levels of remuneration and other entitlements of the Premier, other Ministers,
the members of the Assembly who are not Ministers, and the Speaker.
(2) The Premier, the other Ministers, the members of the Niue Assembly
who are not Ministers, and the Speaker may receive such remuneration and
allowances and such other benefits as may be prescribed by Act.
(3) If, in the opinion of the Speaker, any Bill, or any amendment to any
Bill, deals with a matter to which this Article relates, that Bill or that amendment
may not be introduced unless –
(a) There is before the Assembly a report and recommendations made
by the Niue Public Service Commission pursuant to this Article;
and
(b) The issues raised by that Bill or by that amendment are, in the
opinion of the Speaker, substantially similar to those considered in
the Commission’s report and recommendations.

26 Dissolution of the Niue Assembly

(1) The Speaker shall, by notice in the Niue Gazette dissolve the Niue
Assembly –
(a) At the expiration of 3 years from the date of the last preceding
general election, if it has not been sooner dissolved;
(b) At any time after the expiration of 2 years and 9 months from the
date of the last preceding general election, if the Premier so requests;
(c) If, pursuant to Article 6(3) of this Constitution, the Premier requests
him to dissolve the Assembly;
12 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) If a new election of Premier has been held pursuant to Article 5(4) of this Constitution and that new election has become of no effect pursuant to that subclause.
(2) There shall be a general election of the members of the Niue Assembly at such time, being not less than 4 weeks nor more than 6 weeks after the date of every dissolution of the Assembly, as the Speaker shall, at the request of the Premier, appoint, or, if the Premier makes no such request within 7 days of any dissolution, as the Speaker, acting in his own discretion, shall appoint, by notice in the Niue Gazette.

27 Clerk of the Niue Assembly

(1) There shall be an officer of the Niue Public Service to be called the
Clerk of the Niue Assembly, who shall be responsible for –
(a) Arranging the business and keeping the records of the proceedings
of the Niue Assembly; and
(b) Arranging for the signing of documents and giving of certificates
by the Speaker, whenever any signature or certification by the
Speaker is required pursuant to this Constitution or to any
enactment, and keeping the records of all documents and certificates
so signed or given.
(2) The Clerk of the Niue Assembly shall perform with respect to the
Speaker and to the members of the Assembly such secretarial and other functions
as may be required.

28 Power to make laws

The Making of Laws

(1) Subject to this Constitution, the Niue Assembly may make laws for the peace, order, and good government of Niue.
(2) The powers of the Niue Assembly shall extend to the making, in relation
to Niue, of laws having extraterritorial operation, that is to say, affecting or
concerning any person or matter or thing outside Niue or any act done or omitted
outside Niue.
(3) Without limiting the generality of the powers conferred by this Article,
those powers shall include the power to repeal or revoke or amend or modify or
extend, in relation to Niue, any law in force in Niue.
(4) Except to the extent to which it is inconsistent with this Constitution,
no Act and no provision of any Act shall be deemed to be invalid solely on the
ground that it is inconsistent with any law in force in Niue.

29 Introduction of Bills, etc, into Niue Assembly

Subject to this Constitution and to the Standing Orders of the Niue
Assembly, any member of the Assembly may introduce any Bill or propose any
motion for debate in or present any petition to the Assembly, and the same shall
be considered and disposed of in accordance with the Standing Orders.

30 Restrictions with regard to financial measures

Except with the recommendation or consent of the Premier or another
Minister acting on behalf of the Premier, the Niue Assembly shall not proceed
upon any Bill (including an amendment to any Bill) which, in the opinion of the
Speaker, would dispose of or charge any of the public revenues of Niue, or revoke
or alter, otherwise than by way of reduction, any disposition thereof or charge
thereon, or impose or alter or abolish any toll, rate, due, fee, fine, or tax.

Constitution of Niue 13

31 [Repealed]

32 Special provisions with regard to measures affecting the Niue Public

Service

(1) The Niue Assembly shall not proceed upon any Bill or upon an
amendment to any Bill, after its introduction, if, in the opinion of the Speaker, that
Bill or that amendment makes provision concerning –
(a) The pay, allowances, discipline, control and management of the
Niue Public Service; or
(b) The appointment, promotion, transfer, retirement, removal,
suspension, and dismissal of employees of the Niue Public Service,
including the review of or appeals against any decisions in relation
thereto –
unless the Assembly has before it a report, made by the Niue Public Service
Commission pursuant to this Article, on the legal, constitutional, and policy issues
raised by that Bill or by that amendment.
(2) If, pursuant to this Article, the Assembly by resolution decides to request
the Niue Public Service Commission to report in relation to a Bill or to an
amendment, the Speaker shall cause to be sent to the Niue Public Service
Commission a copy of that resolution, and an account of the Assembly’s discussions
thereon, together with a copy of that Bill, or as the case may be, of that amendment
and of the Bill to which it relates; but, if the Assembly takes a contrary decision,
the Bill or the amendment to which that decision relates shall lapse.
(3) When, pursuant to this Article, the Assembly has received the report of
the Niue Public Service Commission in relation to a Bill or an amendment to a
Bill, and a new or revised amendment is thereafter introduced, the requirements
of this Article shall not apply in relation to that new or revised amendment, unless,
in the opinion of the Speaker, it raises legal, constitutional, or policy issues which
were not raised by the previous request to that Commission or by its report.

33 Special provisions with regard to measures affecting Niuean land

(1) The Niue Assembly shall not proceed upon any Bill or upon an
amendment to any Bill, after its introduction, if in the opinion of the Speaker, that
Bill or that amendment makes provision concerning –
(a) The customary title to Niuean land; or
(b) The alienation of Niuean land; or
(c) The purchase, taking, or other acquisition of Niuean land for any
public purpose; or
(d) [Repealed]
unless the Assembly has before it a report, made by a Commission of Inquiry,
having such powers and authority to summon witnesses and to receive evidence
as are conferred on a Commission of Inquiry by law, on the legal, constitutional,
and policy issues raised by the Bill or by that amendment.
(2) If the Assembly by resolution decides that any Bill or amendment to
which this Article applies is worthy of consideration by a Commission of Inquiry
pursuant to this Article, the Cabinet shall as soon as possible consider whether
and in what manner it should act to enable effect to be given to the Assembly’s
decision; but, if the Assembly takes a contrary decision in relation to any such Bill
or amendment, that Bill or that amendment shall lapse.
(3) Whenever the Assembly has by resolution decided that any Bill or
amendment to which this Article applies is worthy of consideration by a
Commission of Inquiry pursuant to this Article –
14 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) The Cabinet may establish a Commission of Inquiry with appropriate terms of reference, or may make any necessary alteration in the terms of reference of a Commission of Inquiry already established to inquire into any matter affecting Niuean land; and the Premier shall as soon as possible inform the Assembly of any arrangement that has been made by the Cabinet to enable effect to be given to the Assembly’s decision; and
(b) Whenever it appears that such an arrangement has been made by the Cabinet, the Speaker shall cause to be sent to the Commission of Inquiry designated by the Cabinet for the purpose of considering the Bill or the amendment to which the Assembly’s resolution relates a copy of that resolution and an account of the Assembly’s discussions thereon, together with a copy of the Bill or, as the case may be, a copy of the amendment and of the Bill to which it relates, and the Commission of Inquiry shall, pursuant to this Article, in due course make its report to the Assembly.
(4) When, pursuant to this Article, the Assembly has received the report of a Commission of Inquiry in relation to a Bill or to an amendment to a Bill and a new or revised amendment is thereafter introduced, the requirements of this Article shall not apply in relation to that new or revised amendment, unless, in the opinion of the Speaker, it raises legal, constitutional, or policy issues which were not raised by the previous report of that Commission of Inquiry.
(5) In this Article –
“alienation” in relation to Niuean land, means the making or grant of any
transfer, sale, gift, lease, licence, easement, profit, mortgage, charge,
encumbrance, trust, or other disposition, whether absolute or limited,
and whether legal or equitable; and includes a contract to make any
such alienation; and also includes the surrender or variation of a lease,
licence, easement, or profit and the variation of the terms of any other
alienation as hereinbefore defined;
“customary title” means title in accordance with the customs and usages
of Niue;
“Niuean land” means land in Niue vested in the Crown but held by Niueans
according to the customs and usages of Niue; and includes any land
granted by the Crown in fee simple before the 1st day of April 1916 and
any customary land declared to be Niuean freehold land or native
freehold land by an order of any Court before the 1st day of November
1969.

34 When Bills become law

(1) Subject to the requirements of Article 35 of this Constitution in those
cases to which that Article applies, a Bill shall become law if, and only if – (a) It has been passed by the Niue Assembly; and
(b) The Speaker, being satisfied that it has been passed in accordance
with this Constitution and with the Standing Orders of the
Assembly, has endorsed on a copy of the Bill a certificate of
compliance with the requirements of this Article, and has, in the
presence of the Clerk of the Niue Assembly, signed that certificate
and sealed that copy with the Seal of Niue, and inscribed thereon
the date of that signing and sealing; and
(c) The Clerk of the Niue Assembly has, in the presence of the Speaker,
countersigned the certificate on that copy of the Bill.

Constitution of Niue 15

(2) A Bill which becomes law in accordance with the requirements of this
Article, shall be an Act of the Niue Assembly.
(3) Subject to its provisions, an Act shall come into force on the date of its
certification and sealing.

35 Power of the Niue Assembly to repeal or amend this Constitution

(1) A Bill repealing or amending or modifying or extending any of the
provisions of the Niue Constitution Act 1974 or of this Constitution or making
any provision inconsistent with any of those provisions shall become law if, and
only if –
(a) It has been passed by the Niue Assembly in compliance with the following requirements –
(i) On both the final reading, and on the reading which preceded it, the Bill receives the affirmative votes of not less than two- thirds of the total membership of the Assembly, as provided in Article 16(2)(b) of this Constitution; and
(ii) The vote on the final reading takes place at least 13 weeks after but excluding the day of the vote on the reading which preceded it; and
(b) It has thereafter been submitted to a poll, conducted in a manner prescribed by law, of the persons who at the time of that poll were entitled to vote as electors at a general election of members of the Niue Assembly, and has at that poll received the support –
(i) In the case of any Bill repealing or amending or modifying or
extending any of the provisions of sections 2 to 9 of the Niue
Constitution Act 1974 or of Articles 1 and 69 of this Constitution
or of this Article, by two-thirds of the votes validly cast; and
(ii) In any other case, of a majority of the votes validly cast; and
(c) The Speaker, being satisfied that it has been passed in accordance
with this Constitution and with the standing Orders of the
Assembly, has endorsed on a copy of the Bill a certificate of
compliance with the requirements of this Article, and has, in the
presence of the Clerk of the Niue Assembly, signed that certificate
and sealed that copy with the Seal of Niue, and inscribed thereon
the date of that signing and sealing; and
(d) The Clerk of the Niue Assembly has, in the presence of the Speaker,
countersigned the certificate on that copy of the Bill.
(2) A Bill which becomes law in accordance with the requirements of this
Article shall be part of this Constitution and shall be described as a constitutional
amendment.
(3) Subject to its provisions, a constitutional amendment shall come into
force on the date of its certification and sealing.

36 New Zealand Parliament not to legislate for Niue, and New Zealand subordinate legislation not to apply to Niue, except with consent

(1) No Act, and no provision of any Act, of the Parliament of New Zealand passed on or after Constitution Day shall extend to Niue as part of the law of Niue, unless –
(a) The passing of that Act or the making of that provision, so far as it extends to Niue, has been requested and consented to by resolution of the Niue Assembly; and
16 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) It is expressly declared in that Act that the Niue Assembly has requested and consented to the enactment of that Act or of that provision.
(2) No subordinate legislation made after Constitution Day pursuant to any Act of the Parliament of New Zealand shall extend to Niue as part of the law of Niue unless –
(a) At the date of its making, the Act pursuant to which that subordinate legislation was made extends to Niue as part of the law of Niue; and
(b) The extension to Niue of that subordinate legislation has been requested and consented to by the Cabinet of Ministers of Niue; and
(c) It is expressly declared in that subordinate legislation that the Cabinet of Ministers of Niue has requested and consented to that extension.
(3) Any Act of the Parliament of New Zealand which, pursuant to this Article, extends to Niue as part of the law of Niue, shall have the same force and effect as if it were an Act of the Niue Assembly.
(4) In this Article the term “subordinate legislation” means any Order in
Council, Proclamation, regulations, rules, or other subordinate legislation.
PART III THE JUDICIARY

The High Court of Niue

37 High Court established

(1) There shall be a Court of record, to be called the High Court of Niue,
for the administration of justice in Niue.
(2) Except as provided in this Constitution or by law, the High Court shall
have all such jurisdiction (both criminal jurisdiction, and civil jurisdiction including
jurisdiction in relation to land) as may be necessary to administer the law in force
in Niue.
(3) There shall be 3 Divisions of the High Court, namely –
(a) A Civil Division;
(b) A Criminal Division; and
(c) A Land Division.
(4) A Judge of the High Court may exercise any of the jurisdiction and
powers of a Judge of any Division.
(5) Subject to the subclauses (1), (2), (3) and (4) of this Article and to Article
38, each Judge of the High Court, or any 2 or more Judges, may, at any time in
Niue or beyond Niue, exercise all the powers of the High Court.

38 Jurisdiction of Divisions of the High Court

(1) Each Division of the High Court shall hear and determine –
(a) Such proceedings as are, under or by virtue of any enactment, to be
heard and determined by that Division;
(b) Such other proceedings as may from time to time be determined by
the Chief Justice, either generally or in any particular proceedings
or classes of proceedings.
(2) The Land Division shall have all the jurisdiction and powers in relation
to land that immediately before the commencement of this Article were conferred
on the Land Court of Niue, and shall have such other jurisdiction as may be
conferred on it by enactment.

Constitution of Niue 17

39 Judges of the High Court

(1) The High Court shall consist of one or more Judges, each of whom
shall be appointed under the provisions of this Constitution.
(2) If only one Judge is so appointed, he shall be the Chief Justice of Niue,
but if more than one Judge is appointed, one of them shall be appointed as the
Chief Justice of Niue.
(3) A person shall not be qualified for appointment as a Judge of the High
Court under this Article, unless he possesses such qualifications as may, subject to
this Constitution, be prescribed by Act.

40 Acting Chief Justice of the High Court

Where any vacancy exists in the office of Chief Justice, or it appears that
the Chief Justice is, for any reason, for the time being unable to perform the
functions of his office, those functions may be performed by another Judge of the
High Court, and if there is more than one such Judge who is able to perform those
functions, then by the Judge who is senior in terms of the date of his appointment
to that office, and that Judge may continue to perform those functions until a new
Chief Justice is appointed, or, as the case may be, until the Chief Justice is again
able to perform the functions of his office.

41 Temporary Judges

The Cabinet may at any time appoint any person of any age who is otherwise
qualified for appointment to hold office as Chief Justice or as another Judge for
such time, not exceeding one year, as is specified in the warrant of appointment.

Appointment, Tenure of Office, and Salaries of Judges

42 Appointment of Judges

The Chief Justice and other Judges of the High Court shall be appointed as
follows –
(a) The Chief Justice of the High Court shall be appointed by the Governor-General, acting on the advice of Cabinet tendered by the Premier;
(b) The other Judges of the High Court shall be appointed by the Governor-General, acting on the advice of Cabinet tendered by the Chief Justice of the High Court and the Minister of Justice.

43 Tenure of office of Judges

(1) Except in the case of an appointment made under Article 41, no person
who has attained the age of 68 years shall be appointed to or continue to hold
office as the Chief Justice or other Judge of the High Court.
(2) Nothing done by the Chief Justice or other Judge of the High Court in
the performance of his functions shall be deemed to be invalid by reason only that
he has reached the age at which he is required by this Article to retire or that his
term has expired, as the case may be.
(3) The Chief Justice or any other Judge of the High Court may resign his
office in writing under his hand addressed to the Governor-General.

44 Salaries of Judges

(1) The salaries of the Chief Justice and other Judges of the High Court
shall be determined by Act and shall be a charge on the Niue Government Account.
(2) The salaries of those Judges shall not be diminished during their period
of office, unless as part of a general reduction of salaries applied proportionately
to all persons whose salaries are determined by enactment.
18 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

45 Removal of Judges from office

(1) The Chief Justice and any other Judge of the High Court shall not be
removed from office except by the Governor-General acting on the advice of
Cabinet tendered by the Premier and given in accordance with a recommendation
contained in a resolution of the Niue Assembly.
(2) The only ground upon which the Chief Justice and any other Judge
may be removed from office is that of inability to discharge the functions of his
office (whether arising from infirmity of body or mind or from any other cause) or
misbehaviour.

Commissioners of the High Court

46 Commissioners of the High Court

(1) Cabinet may appoint Commissioners of the High Court of Niue, who
shall hold office for such time as shall be specified in their warrants of appointment.
(2) No person who has attained the age of 68 years or who is a Member of
the Niue Assembly shall be appointed to or continue to hold office as a
Commissioner of the High Court.
(3) Subject to subclause (2), the office of Commissioner of the High Court
may with the approval of the Public Service Commission be held concurrently
with any office in the Niue Public Service, or any other position or employment,
but a Commissioner of the High Court who is a member of the Niue Public Service
shall not in the exercise of his functions be under the control of the Niue Public
Service Commission.
(4) Nothing done by a Commissioner of the High Court in the performance
of his functions shall be deemed to be invalid by reason only that he has reached
the age at which he is required by this Article to retire, or that his term of office has
expired.
(5) A Commissioner of the High Court may resign by writing under his
hand addressed to the Premier.

47 Temporary Commissioners

The Cabinet may at any time appoint any person of any age who is otherwise
qualified for appointment to hold office as a Commissioner of the High Court for
such time, not exceeding one year, as is specified in his warrant of appointment.

48 Jurisdiction of Commissioners of the High Court

(1) A Commissioner of the High Court shall possess and may exercise such
of the functions of a Judge of the High Court (whether judicial or administrative,
but excluding those vested exclusively in the Chief Justice) as may be prescribed
by Act, either generally or with respect to any particular Commissioner or
Commissioners of the High Court, and all references in any enactment to a Judge
of the High Court shall be construed as applying to a Commissioner of the High
Court within the limits of the jurisdiction conferred on him.
(2) An Act may provide for appeals from a Commissioner of the High Court
to a Judge of that Court.

49 Remuneration of Commissioners of the High Court

(1) Commissioners of the High Court shall receive such salaries and
allowances as may from time to time be prescribed by enactment; but if any
Commissioner is appointed on terms which do not require him to devote the whole
of his time to performing the duties of that office, he shall receive by way of salary
and allowances, the amount that is appropriate, having regard to the extent of the
duties performed by him and to the terms and conditions of his appointment.

Constitution of Niue 19

(2) The salaries of Commissioners shall be a charge on the Niue
Government Account.
(3) During the term of office of any Commissioner, his salary may be
increased whether to take account of any increase in general levels of remuneration
or for any other reason, but his salary shall not during the term of his office be
reduced, unless as part of a general reduction of salaries applied proportionately
to all persons whose salaries are determined by enactment.

50 Removal of Commissioners from office

(1) A Commissioner of the High Court shall not be removed from office
except by Cabinet, acting in accordance with a recommendation of the Chief Justice.
(2) The only ground upon which a Commissioner may be removed from
office is that of inability to discharge the functions of his office (whether arising
from infirmity of body or mind or from any other cause) or of misbehaviour.

51 Justices of the Peace

Justices of the Peace

(1) The Cabinet may appoint Justices of the Peace for Niue, who shall hold office for such time as may be prescribed in their warrants of appointment.
(2) Any two Justices of the Peace for Niue, acting together, shall possess and may exercise in Niue any of the functions that are by law conferred generally on Commissioners of the High Court; and Article 48 of this Constitution, with the necessary modifications shall apply as if references therein to a Commissioner of the High Court were a reference to any two Justices of the Peace for Niue; but this subclause shall not apply in the case of any Justice of the Peace who is a member of the Niue Assembly or who has attained the age of 68 years.
(3) A Justice of the Peace for Niue shall not be removed from office except
by Cabinet acting in accordance with a recommendation of the Chief Justice.
(4) Justices of the Peace shall receive, in respect of any duties they perform,
such remuneration as may from time to time be prescribed by enactment.

Court of Appeal

52 Court of Appeal established

(1) There shall be a Court of Appeal of Niue, which shall be a superior
Court of record.
(2) Subject to articles 53 and 54, the Judges of the Court of Appeal shall
be –
(a) The Chief Justice and other Judges of the High Court who shall be a member of the Court by virtue of their office; and
(b) Such other persons, possessing such qualifications as shall be prescribed by Act, as may from time to time be appointed by the Governor-General acting on the advice of the Cabinet tendered to him by the Premier.
(3) The Chief Justice shall be the President of the Court of Appeal, but in
his absence the Judge present who is highest in seniority shall preside.
(4) Judges of the Court of Appeal shall take seniority according to their
respective dates of their first appointment as Judges whether of the High Court or
of the Court of Appeal or of any Court in any place outside Niue.
(5) An appointment under paragraph (b) of subclause (2) of this Article
shall be for a period of time or for the trial or hearing of one or more particular
causes or matters, as may be specified in the instrument of appointment.
20 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

53 Number of Judges

(1) Any three Judges of the Court of Appeal may at any time in Niue or
beyond Niue, exercise all the powers of the Court: Provided that the Court may
have its judgment delivered by any one of the Court’s members who is available,
and, if there is no such member, then through the Registrar of the Court of Appeal.
(2) The judgment of the Court of Appeal shall be in accordance with the
opinion of the majority of the Judges present.

54 Judges not to sit on appeals from own decision

A Judge of the Court of Appeal shall not sit on the hearing of an appeal
from any decision made by him or by a Court on which he sat as a member.

55 Determination of Court of Appeal

(1) Except as provided in subclause (2) of this Article, or as may be provided
by enactment, the determination of the Court of Appeal shall be final.
(2) Nothing in this Article shall limit the right of Her Majesty in Council,
upon the petition of any person aggrieved by any decision of the Court of Appeal
to admit that person’s appeal therefrom upon such conditions as Her Majesty in
Council shall think fit to impose.

55A Jurisdiction of Court of Appeal

(1) Subject to the provisions of this Constitution, the Court of Appeal shall
have jurisdiction to hear and determine any appeal from a judgment of the High
Court.
(2) Subject to the provisions of this Constitution, and such time limits as may be prescribed by enactment within which an appeal shall be commenced, and except where under any Act a judgment of the High Court is declared to be final, an appeal shall lie to the Court of Appeal from a judgment of the High Court –
(a) As of right, if the High Court certifies that the case involves a substantial question of law as to the interpretation or effect of any provision of this Constitution;
(b) As of right, from any conviction by the High Court in the exercise of its criminal jurisdiction whereby the appellant has been sentenced to death or to imprisonment for life or for such term, or to such fine, and from any such sentence (not being a sentence fixed by law) as shall be prescribed by Act;
(c) As of right, when the matter in dispute on the appeal amounts to
not less than such value as shall be prescribed by Act;
(d) With the leave of the High Court in any other case, if in the opinion
of that Court the question involved in the appeal is one which by
reason of its general or public importance, or of the magnitude of
the interest affected, or for any other reason, ought to be submitted
to the Court of Appeal for decision;
(e) In such other cases as may be prescribed by Act.
(3) Notwithstanding anything in subclause (2) of this Article, and except
where under any Act a judgment of the High Court is declared to be final, the
Court of Appeal may, in any case in which it thinks fit and at any time, grant
special leave to appeal to that Court from any judgment of the High Court, subject
to such conditions as to security for costs and otherwise as the Court of Appeal
thinks fit.
(4) In this Article the term “judgment” includes any judgment, decree,
order, writ, declaration, conviction, sentence, or other determination.

Constitution of Niue 21

55B Transmission of order of Court of Appeal

The determination of the Court of Appeal on any appeal from the High
Court shall be transmitted to the Registrar of the High Court by the Registrar of
the Court of Appeal under the seal of the Court of Appeal, and judgment shall
thereupon be entered by the High Court in conformity with that determination,
or such other proceedings by way of a new trial or otherwise shall be taken in the
High Court as are required by that determination.

Oath of Allegiance and Judicial Oath

55C Oath of Allegiance and Judicial Oath

(1) The Chief Justice, and other Judges of the High Court, and every Judge
of the Court of Appeal, and every Commissioner, and Justice of the Peace for
Niue, shall, as soon as may be after his acceptance of office, take and subscribe the
following oaths –
(a) An Oath of Allegiance in the following form –
“I,....................................., swear by Almighty God that I will be faithful and bear
true allegiance to Her (or His) Majesty [Specify the name of the reigning Sovereign,
as thus: Queen Elizabeth the Second] as the Head of State of Niue, Her (or His)
heirs, and successors, in accordance with the Constitution and the law. So help me
God”;
(b) The Judicial Oath in the following form –
“I,....................................., swear by Almighty God that I will well and truly serve
Her (or His) Majesty (Specify as above) as the Head of State of Niue, Her (or His)
heirs, and successors in accordance with the Constitution and the law, in the office
of.....................................; and I will do right to all manner of people, without fear
or favour, affection or ill will. So help me God.”
(2) The oaths required to be taken by this Article shall be taken before the
following persons –
(a) In the case of the Chief Justice, before the Governor-General;
(b) In the case of any other Judge of the High Court, or any Judge of
the Court of Appeal, before the Governor-General or before the Chief
Justice;
(c) In the case of the Commissioner of the High Court or a Justice of
the Peace, before the Chief Justice or any Judge of the High Court,
or the Speaker of the Niue Assembly.
(3) If any person mentioned in this Article declines or neglects, when the
oaths required to be taken by him under this Article are duly tendered, to take
those oaths, he shall if he has already entered on his office vacate the same, and if
he has not entered on the same be disqualified from entering on the same; but no
person shall be compelled in respect of the same appointment to the same office
to take any oath more than once: Provided that no proceedings before any such
person may be questioned in any Court solely on the ground that that person
failed to take the oaths prescribed by this Article.
PART IV
THE PUBLIC REVENUES OF NIUE

56 Legislative control of public revenue and expenditure

(1) No taxes shall be imposed except by law.
(2) All revenue received by the Government of Niue shall be paid into an
appropriate public fund or account; and every such fund or account, unless established by existing law, shall be established by or pursuant to Act.
(3) All expenditure of public money, unless authorised by existing law, shall be authorised by Act.
22 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

57 Niue Government Account

(1) There shall be a Niue Government Account.
(2) All taxes and other revenues and money raised or received by the
Government of Niue shall be paid into the Niue Government Account unless
required or permitted by law to be paid into any other public fund or account.

58 Annual estimates and appropriations

(1) Except as provided in Article 59(4)(b) of this Constitution or where
authorised by a specific appropriation contained in any existing law or in any
Act, all expenditure of public money in any financial year shall be charged to
votes specified in the Appropriation Act and in accordance with the estimates for
that year.
(2) Each Appropriation Act shall relate to one financial year, and shall lapse
at the end of that year.

59 Cabinet to supervise expenditure

(1) It shall be the responsibility of the Cabinet to make proposals to the
Assembly as to the projected levels of public revenue and of public expenditure
in each financial year, and as to all other budgetary matters. In particular, the
Premier or another Minister shall introduce or take responsibility in the Assembly
for all Bills relating to financial measures, and for the submission of a detailed
statement of estimated expenditure in respect of each financial year.
(2) The Cabinet shall also be accountable to the Assembly for all public
expenditure, and for relating such expenditure to the appropriations made by the
Assembly pursuant to Article 58 of this Constitution, or to any discretion to approve
expenditure pursuant to subclause (4) of this Article, and shall lay the accounts
for each financial year before the Assembly.
(3) Any delegation by the Cabinet, whether or not to be one or more of its
own members, of the power to approve public expenditure shall, subject to existing
law, be made by or pursuant to Act, and shall be without prejudice to the generality
of the Cabinet’s continuing responsibilities under this Article.
(4) Subject to such lower limits and such restrictions as may from time to
time be prescribed by any enactment, the Cabinet may approve the expenditure
of such sums as it considers necessary –
(a) In anticipation of provision to be made in the Appropriation Act
for any financial year; but the total amount issued and paid under
this paragraph in relation to any vote in any financial year shall not
exceed the unexpended balance of the corresponding vote in the
Appropriation Act for the preceding financial year, together with
an amount equal to one-fourth of that vote, and all money so spent
shall be included in the estimates for that year; or
(b) Where, during the period between the passing of the Appropriation
Act for any financial year and the end of that financial year, it is
desirable that money should be expended in excess of or without
the appropriation of the Niue Assembly, but the total amount of all
sums issued and paid under this paragraph in any financial year
shall not exceed 11/2 percent of the total amount of all sums
appropriated by the Appropriation Act for that financial year.
(5) All expenditure made under subclause (4)(b) of this Article shall be
charged as unauthorised expenditure to the appropriate fund or account.
(6) A statement of the unauthorised expenditure for any financial year shall
be included in the accounts for that year laid before the Assembly.

Constitution of Niue 23

60 Audit

(1) The Audit Office of New Zealand shall be the auditor of the Niue
Government Account and of all other public funds or accounts, and of the accounts
of all Departments and Offices of executive government, and of such other public
or statutory authorities or bodies as may be provided by law.
(2) The Audit Office shall, at least once annually, prepare and forward to
the Speaker of the Niue Assembly for presentation to the Assembly a report
containing such information as is required to be submitted by any enactment,
together with such other information relating to the Niue Government Account,
or to such other funds or accounts which under this Constitution or under any
enactment are required to be audited by the Audit Office, as that office considers
desirable.
PART V
HEALTH, EDUCATION AND OTHER SOCIAL SERVICES

61 Health, education and other social services

(1) The Cabinet shall be responsible for establishing and maintaining in
Niue such hospitals and other institutions and for providing such other services
as it considers necessary for the public health.
(2) The Cabinet shall be responsible for establishing and maintaining in
Niue such public schools and for making such other provision as it considers
necessary to provide educational opportunities for the people of Niue.
(3) The Cabinet shall be responsible for establishing and maintaining such
other institutions and services and for making such other provision as it considers
necessary to provide a reasonable standard of living for the people of Niue and to
secure their economic, social, and cultural welfare.
(4) Nothing in this Article shall be construed as limiting the powers
conferred on the Cabinet by Article 2 of this Constitution to exercise on behalf of
Her Majesty the executive authority of Niue.

62 Niue Public Service

PART VI
THE NIUE PUBLIC SERVICE
(1) There shall be a Niue Public Service comprising such employees as may be necessary to assist the Cabinet in exercising the executive authority of Niue and to perform such other functions or exercise such powers as may be prescribed by law.
(2) Except as provided in subclause (4) of this Article, no person shall be
employed in the service of the Government of Niue unless he is an employee of
the Niue Public Service.
(3) Except as may otherwise be provided by Act, employment by a public
corporation or other statutory authority or public body constituted under the law
of Niue shall, for the purposes of this Article, be considered as employment in the
service of the Government of Niue.
(4) Subclause (2) of this Article shall not apply to service remunerated by
way of fees or commission only, or honorary service, or service as –
(a) A Judge or Commissioner of the High Court or a Justice of the Peace
for Niue, or any other judicial officer appointed by or pursuant to
existing law or Act; or
(b) A Minister, or any other member or the Speaker of the Niue
Assembly; or
(c) A member of the Niue Public Service Commission.
24 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

63 Secretary to the Government

(1) There shall be an officer of the Niue Public Service to be called the
Secretary to the Government, who shall be the permanent head of the Niue Public
Service and the chief administrative officer of the Government of Niue.
(2) In addition to the other functions and powers conferred upon him by
law, the Secretary to the Government shall be responsible to the Cabinet for the
general direction of the work of all departments and offices of the executive
government. The head of each Department or office shall account for the work of
that Department or office to the Secretary to the Government, as well as to the
Minister primarily responsible for that Department or office or, as the case may
be, for the function performed by that Department or office.
(3) Notwithstanding anything in Article 69(2) of this Constitution, the Niue
Public Service Commission shall consult the Premier and shall obtain the
concurrence of the Cabinet before it appoints any person to be Secretary to the
Government.
(4) Notwithstanding anything in any enactment, no appeal by any
employee of the Niue Public Service shall lie against the promotion or appointment
of any person to the office of Secretary to the Government.

Niue Public Service Commission

64 Niue Public Service Commission

(1) There shall be a Public Service Commission for Niue, to be called the
Niue Public Service Commission.
(2) The Commission shall consist of 3 members who shall be appointed by
the Cabinet.
(3) The Chairman of the Commission shall be appointed by the Cabinet
from amongst the members of the Commission.
(4) Each member of the Commission, and the Chairman, shall be appointed
for a term of 3 years but may from time to time be reappointed.
(5) Each member of the Commission shall receive such salary allowances
and benefits as the Cabinet determines from time to time.
(6) A member of the Commission may resign his office at any time by
written notice to the Premier, or may be removed from office by the Cabinet on
the ground that he is unable to discharge the functions of his office (whether by
reason of infirmity of body or mind or from any other cause) or misbehaviour.

65 Acting members of Commission

(1) In the event of the incapacity, by reason of illness or absence or any
other cause, of any member of the Commission, the Cabinet may appoint a person
to act in place of that member during that incapacity.
(2) Any person acting in place of a member of the Commission pursuant
to this Article shall be deemed for all purposes to be a member of the Commission,
and no appointment of any such person, and no act done by him in his capacity as
a member of the Commission shall in any proceedings be questioned on the ground
that the occasion for his appointment had not arisen or had ceased.

66 Procedure of Commission

(1) At all meetings of the Niue Public Service Commission, 2 members
shall form a quorum.
(2) The Commission shall have power to invite such other persons as it
thinks fit to assist in its deliberations.
(3) At least 2 members of the Commission shall concur in any decision of
the Commission.

Constitution of Niue 25

(4) Any matter which may be decided by the Commission at a meeting may also be decided by a minute of the Commission signed by all the members. (5) Subject to this Constitution, the Commission shall regulate its own
procedure.

67 Delegation of powers

(1) Without prejudice to its continuing responsibility for the organisation
and management of the Niue Public Service, the Commission may from time to
time, either generally or particularly, delegate any of its powers in relation to the
Niue Public Service (including this power of delegation) to any of its members or
any other person or to the Secretary to the Government.
(2) Subject to any general or special directions given by the Commission, a
person to whom any powers are so delegated may exercise those powers in the
same manner and with the same effect as if they had been conferred on him directly
by enactment and not by delegation.
(3) Every person purporting to act pursuant to any delegation under this
Article shall, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be presumed to be acting in
accordance with the terms of the delegation.
(4) Any delegation under this section may be made to a specified person
or to persons of a specified class, or may be made to the holder for the time being
of a specified office.
(5) The delegation of any powers under this section shall not prevent the
exercise of those powers by the Commission or by any person making the
delegation.

Management of Niue Public Service

68 Functions and powers of Commission

(1) The Niue Public Service Commission shall be the employing authority
for the Niue Public Service, and, subject to this Constitution, shall have the general
oversight and control of its organisation and management, and shall be responsible
for reviewing the efficiency and economy of all departments and offices of the
executive government.
(2) Subject to this Constitution and to any enactment, the Commission may
prescribe and determine the terms and conditions of employment of members of
the Niue Public Service, and may issue such instructions or exercise such other
powers as may be necessary to enable it to perform the functions and carry out
the duties described in this Constitution or conferred on it by law.
(3) In the performance or exercise of its functions, powers, and duties in
relation to the Niue Public Service, the Commission may conduct such inquiries
and investigations as it considers necessary, and, for the purpose of conducting
any such inquiry or investigation, the Commission shall have such powers and
authority to summon witnesses and to receive evidence as are conferred on a
Commission of Inquiry by law.
(4) Except as provided in Article 69(2) of this Constitution, the Commission
shall be responsible to the Cabinet for the carrying out of its duties and the
performance and exercise of its functions and powers, and the Commission shall,
as necessary, inform and advise the Cabinet in relation to any matter affecting the
Niue Public Service.
(5) The Commission shall as soon as practicable after the 31st day of March
in each year furnish to the Cabinet a report on the state of the efficiency and
economy of the Niue Public Service and on the work of the Commission for the
year ending with that date. A copy of that report shall be laid before the Niue
Assembly.
26 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

69 Appointments to Niue Public Service

(1) All employees of the Niue Public Service shall be appointed by the
Niue Public Service Commission and, subject to this Constitution and to any
enactment, shall hold office on such terms and conditions as may from time to
time be prescribed or determined by the Commission.
(2) In all matters relating to decisions about individual employees (whether
they relate to the appointment, promotion, demotion, transfer, disciplining, or
cessation of employment of any employee or any other matter) the Commission
shall not receive any direction from the Cabinet, but shall act independently.
(3) In establishing and revising the terms and conditions of employment
in the Niue Public Service, the factors to be taken into account shall include –
(a) The need for the Niue Public Service to recruit and retain an efficient
staff, and, in particular, to provide varied careers and adequate
advancement for Niueans with special skills;
(b) The need to afford reasonable opportunities of employment in Niue
for the people of Niue, and in so doing to have regard to the
employment opportunities and levels of remuneration available in
New Zealand;
(c) The need to act consistently with Government economic and social
policy, bearing in mind that the terms and conditions of employment
in the Niue Public Service are a major element in the general well­
being of Niue.
(4) The pay and allowances of employees of the Niue Public Service shall
be paid from the Niue Government Account out of money appropriated by the
Niue Assembly.

Reports and Recommendations to Assembly

70 Commission to make certain reports and recommendations to Assembly

(1) Pursuant to Article 25 of this Constitution, the Niue Public Service
Commission shall from time to time consider whether circumstances require the
making of a report and recommendations to the Assembly as to the levels of
remuneration and other entitlements of the Premier, the other Ministers, the
members of the Assembly who are not Ministers, and the Speaker, and the
Commission shall make such a report and recommendations, whenever there is a
general alteration of the levels of remuneration of employees of the Niue Public
Service.
(2) The Commission shall send to the Speaker any report and
recommendations made under subclause (1) of this Article.
(3) Whenever, pursuant to Article 32 of this Constitution, the Niue Public
Service Commission is requested to report on the legal, constitutional, and policy
issues raised by any Bill or amendment, it shall as soon as possible, and in any
case within one month after receiving the papers relating to the Bill or amendment,
respond to that request, either by furnishing its report to the Speaker, or, if it requires
further time or information before forming a final opinion, by making that known
to the Speaker.

Constitution of Niue 27

PART VII TRANSITIONAL PROVISIONS

71 Existing law to continue

Subject to this Constitution –
(a) The existing law shall, until repealed, and subject to any amendment
thereof, continue in force on and after Constitution Day;
(b) All rights, obligations, and liabilities arising under the existing law
shall continue to exist on and after Constitution Day, and shall be
recognised, exercised, and enforced accordingly.

72-80 [Spent]

81 Seal of Niue

Until the Cabinet approves a different form or forms, the Seal of Niue
established by Article 15 of this Constitution shall be in the form or forms approved
by the Executive Committee for the Seal of Niue established by section 7 of the
Niue Act 1966 (as substituted by section 3 of the Niue Amendment Act 1971).

82 Interpretation

PART VIII INTERPRETATION
(1) In this Constitution, unless the context otherwise requires –
“Act” means an Act of the Niue Assembly, as that term is used in Article 34
of this Constitution;
“Cabinet” means the Cabinet of Ministers of Niue established by Article 2
of this Constitution;
“Chief Justice” means the Chief Justice of the High Court of Niue appointed
under Article 42 of this Constitution; and includes any other Judge of
the High Court authorised under Article 40 of this Constitution to
perform the office or exercise any function of the Chief Justice;
“Clerk of the Cabinet” means the Clerk of the Cabinet appointed pursuant
to Article 14 of this Constitution;
“Clerk of the Niue Assembly” means the Clerk of the Niue Assembly
appointed pursuant to Article 27 of this Constitution;
“Constitution” means this Constitution; and includes the Act of the
Parliament of New Zealand intituled the Niue Constitution Act 1974;
and also includes any constitutional amendment, as that term is used
in Article 35 of this Constitution, when that constitutional amendment
has come into force;
“Constitution Day” means the date on which this Constitution comes into
force;
“Court of Appeal” means the Court of Appeal of Niue established by Article
52 of this Constitution;
“enactment” means –
(a) Any Act of the Niue Assembly and any Ordinance; and any
regulation, rule, bylaw, or other instrument of a like nature made
pursuant to any such Act or Ordinance;
(b) Any Act of the Parliament of New Zealand which extends to Niue
as part of the law of Niue; and any Order in Council, Proclamation,
regulation, rule, ministerial warrant, bylaw, or instrument of a like
nature, made pursuant to any Act to which this paragraph applies,
if that Order in Council, Proclamation, regulation, rule, ministerial
28 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
warrant, bylaw, or other instrument extends to Niue as part of the law of Niue;
“existing law” means any law in force in Niue immediately before Constitution Day; and includes any enactment passed or made before Constitution Day and coming into force on or after Constitution Day; “High Court” means the High Court of Niue established by Article 37 of
this Constitution;
“Judge” in relation to the High Court, means any Judge of that Court
including the Chief Justice;
“law” means any law for the time being in force in Niue; and includes this
Constitution and any enactment;
“Member of the Niue Assembly,” or “Member” used in relation to the Niue
Assembly, means any person elected as a member of the Assembly
pursuant to Article 16 of this Constitution; but does not include the
Speaker; and, in any case where the Assembly has been dissolved, shall
have the extended meaning given to that term by subclause (4) of that
Article;
“Minister” means a member of the Cabinet; and includes the Premier; and
also includes any member of the Niue Assembly appointed as a
temporary Minister pursuant to Article 8 of this Constitution;
“Niue Assembly” or “Assembly” means the Niue Assembly established
by Article 16 of this Constitution;
“Niue Public Service” means the Niue Public Service established by Article
62 of this Constitution;
“Niue Public Service Commission” or “Commission” means the Niue Public
Service Commission established by Article 64 of this Constitution;
“Ordinance” means an Ordinance of the Niue Island Assembly or of the
Island Council of Niue;
“Premier” means the member of the Niue Assembly elected as Premier
pursuant to Article 4 of this Constitution after he has been appointed
as a Minister pursuant to Article 5 of this Constitution; and includes
the Minister discharging the functions of Premier pursuant to subclause
(1) or subclause (2) of Article 9 of this Constitution;
“Secretary to the Government” means the Secretary to the Government of
Niue appointed pursuant to Article 63 of this Constitution;
“Speaker” means the Speaker of the Niue Assembly elected pursuant to
Article 20 of this Constitution; and includes any member of the Niue
Assembly performing the functions of Speaker pursuant to that Article.
(2) Where in this Constitution any person is required to subscribe an
oath, he shall be permitted, if he so desires to comply with that requirement by
making and subscribing an affirmation, and the form of oath prescribed by this
Constitution shall be appropriately modified accordingly.
(3) Where under this Constitution the holder of any office is an employee
of the Niue Public Service, any reference to the holder of that office shall be
construed as including, to the extent of his authority, a reference to any other
employee of the Niue Public Service for the time being authorised to exercise or
perform all or any of the powers, duties, and functions of that office.
29

Ko e Fakatufono -Tohi Fakave A Niue

VEHEVEHEAGA

VALA 1 24 Tau mena ataina ki ai e Fono Ekepule Niue

KO E FAKATUFONO PULE FAKATONU A NIUE mo e tau Ekepule ha ha i ai

1 Pule Malolo faka-Fakatufono kua 25 Palepale he Palemia, Tau Ikipule, tau

Fakave ki loto he malolo faka- Ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue mo e

Patuiki Fakatonu Fono

26 Tukuaga he Fono Ekepule Niue

Ko e Fono He Tau Ikipule 27 Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue

2 Ko e Fono He Tau Ikipule a Niue

3 Tau Ikipule kua taha ni e totouaga Ko e Talagaaga he tau Fakatufono-tohi

he ha lautolu a tau malolo kotofa 28 Malolo Kotofa ke taute fakatufono tohi

4 Palemia ha Niue 29 Tukuaga he tau Fakatufono-tohi

5 Kotofaaga he tau Ikipule he mole e fifiliaga Fakalatalata mo e falu a mena kehekehe ki

he Palemia mua he Fono Ekepule Niue

6 Viliaga falanaki ke he Fono he Tau Ikipule 30 Tau fakakaupaaga pauaki ke lata mo e tau

7 Fakaotiaga he tau Kotofaaga he tau Ikipule vahega fekau faka tupe

8 Tau Hukui Ikipule 31 [Uta kehe]

9 Hagai Palemia 32 Tau tauteaga fifili hagaao ke he tau mena

10 Omonuo fakamooli kua lauia ai e Kau Gahua Fakatufono a

11 Tufatufaaga he tau gahua kotofa ke he tau Niue

Ikipule 33 Tau tauteaga fifili ma e tau tauteaga kua

12 Tau Fonoaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule lauia ai e tau vala kelekele Niue

13 Tau Poakiaga, falu a la fono mo e tau 34 Ko e magaaho ka fakamooli ai e tau

fifiliaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule Fakatufono-tohi Fakalatalata ke eke mo tau

14 Fakamau Kupu he Fono He Tau Ikipule Fakatufono-Tohi

35 Pule Malolo ha ha he Fono Ekepule Niue

Fakamailoga a Niue ke uta kehe po ke fakahui e Fakatufono­

15 Fakamailoga a Niue tohi Fakave nai

36 Nakai maeke e Fono Ekepule (Palemene)

VALA II Niu Silani ke talaga e tau fakatufono-tohi

KO E FONO TAUTE FAKATUFONO-TOHI A NIUE ma Niue, mo e nakai maeke ke fakagahua

Ko e Fono Ekepule Niue e tau la fono-tohi Niu Silani a to talia ki ai

16 Fono Ekepule Niue

17 Higoa he motu mo e talahauaga he tau VALA III

nonofoaga he tau tagata vili mo e tau tagata KO E FAAHI GAHUA FAKAFILIAGA

fakatu ke vili ki ai Ko e Fakafiliaga Lahi a Niue

18 Tau tagata gahua fakatufono kua maeke ke 37 Ko e fakatuaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi

fakatu vili po ke fifili ki ai 38 Tau Fakafili mo e tau Komisina Fakafili he

19 Tau Ekepule kua nakai talia ke eke mo tau Fakafiliaga Lahi

tagata gahua he Fakatufono po ke fia 39 Tau Malolo Fakafili ha ha he tau Komisina

manako ke he falu gahua Fakatufono Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi

20 Fakatonu Fono he Fono Ekepule

21 Tau Ekepule ke eke e Omonuo he mahani Ko e Fakafiliaga Fonua Niue

Fakamooli

40

Fakatuaga he Fakafiliaga Fonua

22

Fakaholoaga gahua he Fono Ekepule Niue

41

Tau Fakafili mo e tau Komisina Fakafili he

23

Tau vagahau

Fakafiliaga Fonua

30 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

42 Tau malolo Fakafili ha ha he tau Komisina

Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Fonua

Ko e Fakafiliaga Fonua Tokoluga a Niue

43 Fakafiliaga Fonua Tokoluga a Niue

44 Tau Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Fonua Tokoluga

Kotofaaga, Magahala he Kotofaaga, mo e tau

Palepale he tau Fakafili mo e tau Komisina Fakafili

45 Kotofaaga he tau Fakafili mo e tau

Komisina Fakafili

46 Magahala he Kotofaaga he tau Fakafili mo

e tau Komisina Fakafili

47 Tau Fakafili mo e tau Komisina Fakafili

Hukui

48 Hukui Iki Fakafili Lahi he Fakafiliaga Lahi

mo e Hukui Iki Fakafili Lahi he Fakafiliaga

Fonua

49 Utakeheaga he tau Fakafili mo e tau

Komisina Fakafili mai he tau kotofaaga

50 Tau Palepale he tau Fakafili mo e tau

Komisina Fakafili

Tau Ole mai he Fakafiliaga Lahi ke liu Fakafili

51 Ole he Fakafiliaga Lahi ke liu fakafili ke he

Fakafiliaga Ole Liu Fakafili a Niu Silani

52 Fakafanoaga he Poakiaga he Fakafiliaga

Ole Liu Fakafili ke lata mo e ole liu fakafili

Tau Lagomatai Fakafili

53 Tau Lagomatai Fakafili

Omonuo he Mahani Fakamooli mo e Omonuo

54 Omonuo he Mahani Fakamooli mo e

Omonuo Faka-Fakafiliaga

Talahauaga mai he Iki Fakafili Lahi ke lata mo e a falu a Fakatufono-tohi Fakalatalata

55 Iki Fakafili Lahi ke fai talahauaga ke lata mo e falu a Fakatufono-tohi Fakalatalata

55A Malolo Pule Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili

55E Utaaga he tau Poakiaga Tohi he Fakafiliaga

Liu Fakafili

55I Omonuo he Mahani Fakamooli mo e

Omonuo Faka-Fakafiliaga

VALA IV

TAU TUPE MOUA HA NIUE

56 Levekiaga Faka-Fakatufono he tau tupe

moua mo e tau tupe fakamole

57 Fakaputuaga Tupe he Fakatufono Niue

58 Fakalatalataaga mo e Tufatufaaga he tau

tupe ma e tau taha

59 Ko e Fono He Tau Ikipule ke kitekite e

fakamoleaga he tau tupe

60 Siviaga he tau tupe

VALA V

FAAHI MALOLO TINO, FAAHI GAHUA FAKAAKO MO

E FAAHI FIAFIA TINO

61 Faahi Malolo Tino, Faahi Gahua Fakaako

mo e Faahi Fiafia Tino

VALA VI

KO E KAU GAHUA FAKATUFONO NIUE

62 Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue

63 Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono

Kau Pule Gahua Niue

64 Kau Pule Gahua Niue

65 Tau Tagata Hukui he Kau

66 Puhala Gahua he Kau

67 Ko e foakiaga he tau malolo kotofa

Gahuahuaaga he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue

68 Tau gahua mo e tau malolo kotofa he Kau

69 Tau kotofaaga ke he Kau Gahua Fakatufono

Niue

Tau Fakailoaaga mo e Pulega atu ke he Fono

Ekepule

70 Ko e tau fakailoaaga mo e tau pulega atu

he Kau Pule Gahua ke he Fono Ekepuke

VALA VII

TAU FAKATOKATOKAAGA MA E MATUTAKIAGA

71 Ke fakatumau e tau Fakatufono-tohi a Niue

72-80 Ko e falu vala he tohi fakave nei kua nakai

tuai fakaaoga

81 Ko e Fakamailoga a Niue

VALA VIII FAKAMAAMAAGA

82 Fakamaamaaga

31

FAKATUFONO-TOHI FAKAVE

VALA I
KO E FAKATUFONO PULE FAKATONU A NIUE

1 Pule Malolo faka-fakatufono kua fakave ki loto he malolo faka-Patuiki

Ko e pule malolo faka-fakatufono a Niue kua fakave ke he Patuiki Fifine
Lilifu ke he tonuhia a Niu Silani, ti ko e Kovana Lahi Niu Silani ko ia kua talahau
ai ko e hukui he Patuiki Fifine Lilifu ke lata ai mo Niue.

Ko e Fono He Tau Ikipule

2 Fono He Tau Ikipule a Niue

(1) To ha ha i ai e taha Fono He Tau Ikipule a Niue, (kua talahau ai pehe ko
e Fono He Tau Ikipule) ti ki a ha ha i ai e Palemia a Niue (ko ia ni ko e taha ekepule
he Fono Ekepule) mo e toko 3 foki e ekepule mai he Fono Ekepule Niue.
(2) Ke lata mo e Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, ko e pule malolo faka­
fakatufono a Niue to maeke ke faka-gahua ai he Fono He Tau Ikipule ma e higoa
he Patuiki Lilifu, ha kua ha i ai e tau fakatonuaga katoatoa mo e levekiaga pule
malolo faka-fakatufono ha Niue mo e taute e falu a gahua mo e tau malolo kotofa,
tuga he toka i loto he tau fakatufono-tohi.

3 Tau Ikipule kua taha ni e totouaga he ha lautolu a tau malolo kotofa

(1) Ko lautolu he Fono He Tau Ikipule (kua fakahigoa ai ko e tau Ikipule)
to taha ni a lautolu ke he mahani faka-fehagai mo e falanaki atu ke he Fono Ekepule
Niue.
(2) A to kehe kaeke ko e muitua ke he Matakupu 7 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, ko e tau Ikipule ki a fakatumau ai a lautolu he kotofaaga a to kotofa ai e tau hukui ha lautolu ke lata mo e Matakupu 5 (2) he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai.

4 Palemia ha Niue

(1) To ha ha i ai e taha Palemia ha Niue, ko ia ne fifili ai ke he numela
tokologa he tau Ekepule kua nakai taumaleku e tokologa mai ia lautolu e tau
Ekepule kua ha ha i ai ke he fono he Fono Ekepule Niue mo e eke vili ai i loto he
fonoaga.
(1) Ko e poakiaga ke he Fono Ekepule Niue ke fifili e Palemia he fonoaga
fakamua he Fono Ekepule, he mole e viliaga lahi mo e pihia foki he tau magaaho
kehekehe nai.
(a) Ka fakaoti e kotofaaga Ekepule he Palemia he Fono Ekepule, ha ko
e taha kakano kehe ka e nakai ko e tukuaga he Fono Ekepule; po ke
(e ) Ka eke ke tuku atu he Palemia haana a tohi fakaoti kotofa, kua
taute e tohi ia ti tuku atu ai ke he Fakatonu Fono po ke kaeke kua
fakaoti tuai ke lata mo e Matakupu 6 (3) po ke Matakupu 7(3) he
Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai.

5 Kotofaaga he tau Ikipule he mole e fifiliaga he Palemia

(1) Ko e magaaho tote ia ni he mole e fifiliaga haana ke he kotofaaga, ko ia
e Palemia fifili, kua poaki nei ki a ia ke fakatu higoa ke he Fakatonu Fono, ha kua
talia e lautolu, toko 3 e tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue ke lata mo e tau kotofaaga
Ikipule.
(1) Ka moua e ia e tau higoa fakatutu na, ko ia e Fakatonu Fono, kua poaki
nei kia ia ke kotofa mo tau Ikipule e Palemia fifili mo e tau ekepule ne kua fakatu
higoa ki ai.
32 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) Ko e tau kotofaaga ne eke ai i lalo he vala kupu (2) he Matakupu nai, to taute ai he Fakatonu Fono ke he mahani he tohi kua taute ai i lalo he Fakamailoga a Niue.
(3) Kaeke ke nakai eke ai he Palemia fifili, ke he tau aho ne 7, ka e nakai totou e aho ne fifili ai a ia ke he kotofaaga, e poaki ke tuku atu e ia ke he Fakatonu Fono e tau higoa fakatutu haana ma e tau kotofaaga ke he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke lata mo e Matakupu nai, ti ko e haana a fifiliaga ke he kotofaaga na to nakai tuai nofo ai ha malolo, ti kia fakahoko vave e taha fono he Fono Ekepule Niue ke liu foki fifili ai e Palemia, mo e onoono atu ke he Matakupu 26 (1) (o) he Fakatufono­ tohi Fakave nai.

6 Viliaga falanaki ke he Fono He Tau Ikipule

(1) He ha Fonoaga he Fono Ekepule Niue –
(a) Ko e Palemia po ke taha Ikipule kua eke mo hukui he Palemia, kua
maeke ia ia, ke taute taha fakailoaaga hagaao ke he haana manatu
ke pulega e taha viliaga falanaki ke he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke taute
pauaki po ke taha mena taute kua pulega ki ai e Fono He Tau Ikipule
ke talia ki ai e Fono Ekepule;
(e) Ko e toko 4 po ke tokologa atu foki e tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule,
ko lautolu nakai ko e tau Ikipule, kua maeke ia lautolu ke taute
taha fakailoaaga he ha lautolu a manatu ke pulega e taha viliaga
kua faka-hagaao ko e nakai fai falanakiaga e Fono Ekepule ke he
Fono He Tau Ikipule.
(2) Ko e ha kupu pulega ne fai fakailoaaga kua eke ai i lalo he vala kupu
(1) he Matakupu nai kua poaki ia ke vili ki ai i loto he taha fonoaga he Fono
Ekepule Niue ne kua fono ai he vaha loto he nakai tote hifo e 5 a tau aho po ke
lakafia e 10 e tau aho he mole, ka e nakai lafi ki ai e aho ne eke ai e fakailoaaga.
(3) Kaeke kua kaumahala e kupu pulega kua fai falanakiaga, po ke tuga ni
he pulega ki ai kua kautu tuai e kupu pulega nakai fai falanakiaga, ti ko ia e
Palemia kua talahau pehe ai kua fakaoti tuai e ia haana a kotofaaga he mole e 5 e
tau aho,ka e nakai lafi ki ai ai e aho ne fono ai e Fono Ekepule Niue, a to kehe ka
nakai la katoa e tau aho na ti ko ia e Palemia kua ole atu kehe Fakatonu Fono ke
tuku e Fono Ekepule ka e taute e viliaga lahi.

7 Fakaotiaga he tau kotofaaga he tau Ikipule

(1) Ko e taha he tau Ikipule, ka e nakai ko e Palemia, kua poaki nai kia ia ke
toka haana a gahua kaeke­
(a) Ko e haana a kotofaaga ke he haana gahua na kua uta ke he tuai he
Fakatonu Fono ke he mahani he tohi ha ko e ole atu he Palemia he
taha tohi kua fakamailoga aki e Fakamailoga a Niue; po ke
(e) Kua okioki tuai a ia mai he kotofaaga ekepule he Fono Ekepule
Niue ha ko e ha kakano kehe ka e nakai ka tuku e Fono Ekepule; po
ke
(i) Kua fakaoti tuai e ia haana a gahua ke he taha tohi kua tohi ke he
matalima tohi haana mo e tuku atu ke he Fakatonu Fono.
(2) He vaha loto he 7 e aho he mole ne tokanoa ai e taha pu gahua he taha
Ikipule, ka e nakai ko e Palemia,ko ia e Palemia he mogoia ke pulega fakatu higoa
ekepule ha kua talia he ekepule na, ki a ia e Fakatonu Fono, ko e ekepule mai he
Fono Ekepule ke kotofa ai ke eke mo taha Ikipule, ti ko ia e Fakatonu Fono kua
poaki ki ai, ke kotofa e ekepule ia ne kua fakatu higoa ki ai ke eke mo Ikipule, ke
he taha tohi kua fakamailoga aki e Fakamailoga a Niue.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 33

(3) Kaeke ke nakai fakailoa ai he Palemia he vaha loto he tau aho ne 7 he mole, ka e nakai lafi ki ai e aho ne tokanoa ai e pu gahua he taha Ikipule, ka e nakai ko e Palemia, ke pulega kotofa ai taha mo Ikipule ke lata mo e vala kupu (2) he Matakupu nai, to talahau ai pehe kua fakaoti tuai e ia haana a kotofaaga ko e Palemia he oti e magaaho ko e 7 e tau aho na.

8 Tau Ikipule Hukui

(1) Kaeke kua kitia ai he Palemia kua nakai maeke he ha Ikipule, ha kua
gagao po ke fano kehe ai mai i Niue, ke taute ai e haana a tau gahua kotofa i Niue
ke he magahala ko e 7 e tau aho po ke leva atu foki, ko e Palemia, kua poaki ki ai
ke pulega fakatu higoa atu kehe Fakatonu Fono ke eke mo Ikipule Hukui e taha
ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue, ke he haana taliaaga, ti ka e poaki ai nai ke he
Fakatonu Fono ke kotofa ai e ekepule na ke he taha tohi kua eke ai i lalo he
Fakamailoga a Niue tuga he pulega ke eke pihia.
(2) Ko e ha Ikipule Hukui leveki pehe na, ki a kotofa ai ke hukui e Ikipule
ne kua nakai maeke ke taute e haana a tau gahua kotofa i Niue, ka e muitua ke he
vala kupu (3) he Matakupu nei, kia gahua ai a ia tuga mo e mena kua kotofa
pauaki ni a ia i lalo he Matakupu 5 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai.
(3) Ko e ha kotofaaga Ikipule Hukui Leveki, a to kehe ai ni kaeke kua toka
e ia haana kotofa ke lata mo e Matakupu 7 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, to
tumau a ia ke he kotofaaga a to maeke he Ikipule ne hukui e ia ke liu taute e haana
a tau gahua kotofa i Niue.

9 Palemia Hukui Leveki

(1) Ko e ha magaaho ni, ha ko e gagao po ke fano ke he mai i Niue e Palemia,
ti nakai maeke ai a ia ke eke ai haana a tau gahua kotofa i Niue, ko e Fakatonu
Fono, ha kua ole atu e Fono He Tau Ikipule, to maeke ia ia ke he taha tohi kua tohi
ai i lalo he Fakamailoga a Niue, ke kotofa e taha Ikipule ke taute e tau gahua
kotofa he Palemia a to hoko mai e magaaho kua maeke ai he Palemia ke liu taute
haana a tau gahua kotofa, po ke kua fano kehe tuai a ia mai he haana a kotofaaga.
(2) Ha kua mate tuai e Palemia, po ke kua tuku atu tuai e ia ke he Fakatonu
Fono e haana manatu fakaoti e kotofaaga haana he mole atu e tuku he Fono Ekepule
Niue ka e fakahoko e viliaga lahi, mo e fakamua to kotofa ai e tau Ikipule he mole
e viliaga lahi, mo e fakamua to kotofa ai e tau Ikipule he mole e viliaga lahi ne mui
mai he tukuaga na, ko ia e Fakatonu Fono, ha kua ole atu he Fono He Tau Ikipule,
kua poaki ai nai ke taute e ia ke ha taha tohi kua eke ai i lalo he Fakamailoga a
Niue, ke kotofa e taha Ikipule ke taute e tau gahua kotofa he Palemia a to hoko e
magaaho ke kotofa ai e tau Ikipule he mole atu e viliaga lahi na.

10 Omonuo Fakamooli

Ko e tau Ikipule taki tokotaha oti, fakamua to eke ai e tau gahua kotofa he
haana a kotofaaga, to taute ai e ia e omonuo nai ki mua he Fakatonu Fono.
Ko au ko, kua fifili tuai au mo e talia ai ke eke mo Palemia a Niue (po ke Ikipule) kua omonuo nai au ke he Atua Malolo oti kana to eke e au ke he haaku a fifiliaga tonu kua mua ue atu, ke he tau magaaho oti kua lata ke pihia ai, to foaki mo e fakamakai e au haaku a tau fakatonuaga oti ke moua mai e levekiaga mitaki he tau gahua he motu ko Niue, mo e to nakai fakakite fakatonu e au po ke ha puhala kehe e tau mena kua lata ke tutala galo ki ai i loto he Fono He Tau Ikipule po ke taha Komiti he Fono He Tau Ikipule mo e tuku mai ai ke he haaku a mahani galo, to eke au ke he tau mena oti pehe na mo Palemia mitaki mo e fakamooli ha Niue (po ke Ikipule). Ko e mena ia kia lagomatai mai au ma Atua na e.
34 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

11 Tufatufaaga he tau gahua kotofa ke he tau Ikipule

(1) Ko e Palemia kia eke ai, mai he taha magahala ke he taha magahala, ke
he taha tohi kua tohia ai he lima haana mo e fakamooli ai e higoa he Fakamau
Kupu he Fono He Tau Ikipule mo e lolomi ai i loto he Kasete Niue, e tufatufaaga
he tau gahua kotofa ke he ha Ikipule (lafi ki ai foki a ia) e taha levekiaga gahua he
ha Faahi Gahua Fakatufono po ke tau gahua he Fakatufono mo e maeke ai ke he
puhala taha ia ke fakakehekehe e ha tufatufaaga pehe na.
(2) Ko e Palemia ka ha ha i ai e tonuhia poaki ke taute e ha gahua leveki ke
lata mo e ha Faahi Gahua he Fakatufono po ke ha fekau he Fakatufono kaeke ko e
tau gahua ia kua nakai tufa po ke nakai la tufa tuga ne talahau ai he vala kupu (1)
he Matakupu nai.

12 Tau Fono he Fono He Tau Ikipule

(1) To nakai maeke ke taute ai ha gahua i loto he ha fonoaga he Fono He
Tau Ikipule a to ha ha i ai e toko 3 e tau Ikipule i loto he fonoaga.
(2) To nakai maeke ke tiaki po ke uta kehe e ha tauteaga he Fono He Tau
Ikipule mai he tau tauteaga he tau gahua ha kua pehe ko e fai taha ia lautolu kua
nakai la kotofa, po ke ha mena kua lakafia atu ke he Matakupu 8 he Fakatufono
tohi Fakave nei, ti nakai fai kotofaaga kua taute ai ke lata mo e Matakupu na. To
nakai fai gahua faka fonoaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke huhu hagaao pehe kua
nakai aoga ha kua fai tagata hukui i loto he Fono ne gahua tuga ni ko e taha
Ikipule ka e nakai lata ke ha ha i ai e talahauaga ko e hukui mooli.
(3) Ko e tau Fakailoaga he tau fonoaga takitaha oti mo e taha lagaki he tau
pepa fono oti ka tutala ki ai he fonoaga na, kua poaki ai nei ke tufa atu ke he tau
Ikipule takitaha mo e Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono.
(4) Ko e Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono to ha ha ia ia e tonuhia ke fakalataha
atu ke he ha fonoaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule mo e maeke ke vagahau ai ke he ha
mena kua tutala ki ai e Fono, mo e kua nakai maeke a ia ke noa nakai fakalataha
atu a ia kaeke kua manako e Palemia ki ai.
(5) Koe fifiliaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke he ha mena tutala to maeke ke
taute ni he tau Ikipule kua ha ha i ai he fonoaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule.
(6) Mo e fakatatai atu ke he Matakupu nai, to maeke ni he Fono He Tau
Ikipule ke utauta ha lautolu a tau tauteuteaga kupu mo e tau fakatokaaga puhala
gahua ke he ha puhala kua manatu a lautolu kua lata.

13 Tau Poakiaga, falu a la fono, mo e tau fifiliaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule

Ko e ha poakiaga po ke ha tauteaga faka fakatufono-tohi kua eke ai he
Fono He Tau Ikipule mo e tau fakamauaga he ha fifiliaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule
to maeke ni ke fakamau mo e taofi tonu ki ai ka eke kua fakamooli ai he Palemia
e ha poakiaga, falu a tauteaga faka fakatufono po ke fakamauaga he fifiliaga na,
pete ni po kua ha ha i ai a ia po ke nakai ha ha i ai i loto he fonoaga he Fono He Tau
Ikipule ne eke po ke taute ai e poakiaga po ke taha fakatufono po ke fifiliaga, mo
e fakamooli ai foki he Fakamau Kupu he Fono He Tau Ikipule.

14 Fakamau Kupu he Fono He Tau Ikipule

Kua poaki ai nei ke ha ha i ai e taha tagata gahua he Kau Gahua Fakatufono
Niue ke fakahigoa ai ko e Fakamau Kupu he Fono He Tau Ikipule, ko ia ke lago ki
ai e gahua ke fakatokatoka e tau mena taute, mo e fakamau e tau kupu tutala he
tau fonoaga he Fono He Tau Ikipule mo e fakafano e tau fifiliaga fakamau he Fono
He Tau Ikipule ke he tau tagata kua lata ke fakafano ki ai po ke tau kotofaaga faka
fakatufono, mo e maeke foki ke taute mo e mah`fii lilifu atu ke he Fono He Tau
Ikipule e tau gahua faka-fakamau kupu mo e falu foki he tau gahua kua lata ke
taute ai.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 35

15 Fakamailoga a Niue

Fakamailoga a Niue

(1)To ha ha i ai e taha Fakamailoga faka-Fakatufono Niue (i loto he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai kua fakahigoa ai ko e Fakamailoga a Niue), ke he taha talagaaga po ke tau talagaaga kua talia ki ai e Fono He Tau Ikipule mai he taha magahala ke he taha magahala.
(2) To toka ai ke he levekiaga he Fakatonu Fono e Fakamailoga a Niue.
(3) Ko e Fakamailoga a Niue to maeke ke fakaaoga ai he Fakatonu Fono ke
lata mo e fakamooliaga tohi matalima he ha tohi faka-fakatufono kua hagaao ke
he Fakatufono Niue po ke tauteaga he ha tohi kua taute ai faka-fakatufono tohi ke
eke ai i lalo he Fakamailoga a Niue.
(4) Ki a mailoga ai he faka-fakafiliaga e Fakamailoga a Niue i loto he tau
Fakafiliaga oti.
VALA II
KOE FONO TAUTE FAKATUFONO-TOHI A NIUE

Ko e Fono Ekepule Niue

16 Fono Ekepule Niue

(1) Kua poaki ai nei ke ha ha i ai i Niue ma Niue e taha Fono taute
fakatufono-tohi ke fakahigoa ai ko e Fono Ekepule Niue.
(2) Kua poaki ai nei ke ha ha he Fono Ekepule Niue –
(a) Ko e Fakatonu Kupu; mo e
(e) Toko uafulu e tau ekepule ke fifili ai he taha vili galo i lalo he puhala
viliaga fakalalolagi katoa ke he puhala nai;
(i) Toko hogofulu-ma-fa e tau ekepule, takitaha a lautolu ke eke
mo hukui ha tau maaga, ti fifili ni he tau tagata vili he maaga a
lautolu takitaha ia;
(ii) Toko ono e tau ekepule ke fifili he tau tagata oti he motu ko
Niue kua tonuhia ke vili, ti eke ai ke lata mo e fifiliaga ia lautolu
e tau ekepule ia, to vili he tau tagata ne tohia ki loto he tau
pepa fakamau higoa tagata vili he tau maaga oti a lautolu na.
(3) Ka e nakai noa mo e muitua atu ke he Matakupu nai, pihia mo e tau
Matakupu 17, 18, 19, 24 mo e 25 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, ko e tau katofia he
tau maaga ke lata mo e mahani he viliaga, ko e tonuhia mo e nakai tonuhia he tau
tagata vili mo e tau tagata fakatutu ke vili ki ai, ko e puhala ke fifili aki e tau
ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue, mo e fakatokatokaaga mo e tau tauteaga he ha
lautolu a tau kotofaaga to tuga ni he fakakite mai ai faka-fakatufono tohi:
Ka e to eke ai pehe –
(a) To ha ha i ai 14 e tau maaga ke lata mo e mahani he viliaga; mo e
(e) Ko e tau tagata takitokotaha oti kua tonuhia ke eke mo tagata vili
ma e viliaga he tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue to lata ni ke vili
i loto he taha, ti taha maka ni, e maaga; mo e
(i) Ha fifiliaga po ke liu fai fifiliaga ke he tau katofia he ha maaga to
maeke ia ke taute ke he mena kua maeke ki ai, mo e kitekiteaga ke
lata mo e gahuahuaaga mitaki he tau mena kua aga ki ai e tau tagata
vili he ha maaga, mo e kua lata ke onoono atu fakamatafeiga ke he
mena ne pehe ki a nakai lakafia atu mamao e tokologa po ke tote
hifo lahi e toko gahoa ke he numela tagata vili he ha maaga ke he.
(4) A to kehe ai ni kaeke kua hagaao kehe e kakano kupu, ko e tau
talahauaga takitaha he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai hagaao ke he taha ekepule he
36 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
Fono Ekepule Niue ko e haana kakano ko e fakahagaao ke he taha ekepule ne fifili ke lata mo e vala kupu (2) (e) he Matakupu nai, ti kaeke ko e talahauaga hagaao ke he taha tagata he Fono Ekepule fakamua he nofo ia ti tuku e Fono Ekepule ka e fakahoko e vili, kua hagaao pihia foki e kupu nei.

17 Tohiaaga ke he motu mo e tau talahauaga ke moua e tonuhia ke eke mo tagata vili mo e tagata fakatu mo vili ekepule

(1) To nakai fai fakakaupaaga e tau poakiaga he ha fakatufono ne tohia ai e falu a tonuhia lafi atu ke moua he tagata e fakaataaga ke eke a ia mo tagata vili ke he viliaga he Fono Ekepule ha Niue, po ke ke fakatu ke eke mo tagata ke vili ki ai, he ha viliaga ekepule, to maeke ni kaeke ko e tagata ia –
(a) (i) Ko e tagata Niu Silani; po ke
(ii) Ko e tagata nofomau i Niue ke tuga ne tohia ai he Fakatufono­
tohi; mo e
(e) Ko e tagata kua fai magahala ne nofomau ai a ia i Niue ke molea e
3 e tau tau; mo e
(i) Ko e tagata nofo i Niue kua katoa e 12 e mahina kamata mai he aho
ne taute ai e tohi ole ke eke mo tagata vili po ke kamata he aho ne
fakatu mo tagata ke vili mo ekepule.
(2) Ke lata mo e kakano he Matakupu nai, ko e taha tagata to maeke ke
talahau ai ko e tagata nofo mau i Niue kaeke, mo e kaeke hokoia ni –
(a) Ko ia kua nofo mooli i Niue; po ke
(e) Nukua nofo mooli a ia i Niue mo e manatu ke nofo ni mo e ai fai
amanakiaga ke nofo he taha motu po ke kautu kehe, po ke kua
nofo a ia i tua a Niue ka e kua tali mai he toka e ia a Niue, ko e
manatu ke liu mo e nofo ai ke he leva nakai fai amanakiaga ke kehe
mai he haana a nofo tumau ai:
Ka e kaeke kua ha ha i ai e ha tagata kua nofo kehe mai i Niue ke he ha magahala
kua molea e 3 e tau tau, to talahau ai kua nakai fai manatu pihia (ke nofo i Niue),
a to kehe ni kaeke ko e magahala katoa ia po ke katoatoa he magahala ia ne nofo
kehe ai pihia ha ko e fano he fakaakoaga po ke falu gahua fakaako, po ke i loto he
fekafekauaga he Fakatufono Niue.

18 Tau tagata gahua Fakatufono kua maeke ke fakatu vili po ke fifili ki ai

(1) Ko e ha tagata gahua he kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue kua fakatu higoa
vili ke eke mo ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue, to maeke ke foaki atu ki a ia e
magahala ke fano kehe mai he haana a gahua ke he muituaaga kua lata moe haana
manako ke he kotofaaga ka e muitua ai ke he tau tauteaga mo e tau fakatokatokaaga
faka fakatufono-tohi.
(2) Kaeke ko e ha tagata gahua pehe na kua fifili ai mo ekepule he Fono
Ekepule, to maeke ai a ia, ha kua fifili tuai, ke talahau kua foaki atu tuai ki a ia e
magahala ke fano kehe ai mai he haana a gahua mo e nakai fai palepale ke moua
e ia mai he haana a fekafekauaga i loto he kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue he magahala
kua nofo higoa ekepule ai a ia.

19 Tau Ekepule kua nakai talia ki ai ke eke mo tau tagata gahua he

Fakatufono po ke fia manako ke he falu a gahua faka-Fakatufono

Ko e nofoa he ha ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue kua poaki nai ke tokanoa ai –
(a) Kaeke kua eke a ia mo taha tagata gahua he kau Gahua Fakatufono
Niue, po ke ko ia ko e taha kua gahua tuai he gahuaaga ia he
magaaho ne fifili ai a ia ti talia e ia e fekafeakuaga palepale ia i loto
he fekafekauaga ia; po ke

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 37

(e ) Ka e kaeke foki kua fai mena aoga ke he mahani he tau mena moua ne moua ia ke he tauteaga po ke fakamakai lahi ke he ha gahua kua maeke ke moua palepale mai he tau tupe he Fakatufono, ka e kehe ai kaeke kua hokotia atu pihia ha kua fakaata ai faka Fakatufono­ tohi.

20 Fakatonu Fono he Fono Ekepule Niue

(1) Ko e kotofaaga Fakatonu Fono he Fono Ekepule Niue kua poaki pehe
ke fifili ai a ia ke he kotofaaga na e lautolu e tau ekepule kua tokologa lahi ha ha he fonoaga mo e taute ai e vili i loto he Fono Ekepule Niue.
(2) Ko e taha tagata ni kua tonuhia ke vili ki ai ke eke mo e ekepule he
Fono Ekepule Niue kua lata ke fifili mo Fakatonu Fono.
(3) Kaeke ko e ha tagata kua fifili ai mo Fakatonu Fono, he magaaho ne
taute ai e viliaga na, ko e ekepule a ia he Fono Ekepule Niue, ti ko e poaki nai ke
toka e ia e haana a kotofa ko e ekepule, he mogo ke hu atu ai a ia ke he tau gahua
kua toka ai ke he kotofaaga he Fakatonu Fono.
(4) Ko e fifiliaga he Fakatonu Fono kua poaki ai nai ke taute ai fakamua to
taute ai e ha gahua kehe ha fonoaga fakamua he Fono Ekepule he mole e tau
viliaga lah¢¸oti, mo e, he taha fonoaga he ha Fono Ekepule kua ui pauaki ma e
fekau na he mogo ia ni kua tokanoa ai e kotofaaga Fakatonu Fono.
(5) Ko e tagata kua fifili ai ke eke mo Fakatonu Fono, ko e fakamua to
kamata gahua ai a ia he haana a tau gahua kotofa, ko e poakiaga ki a ia ke taute
mo e eke ai e ia i mua he Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue i loto he taha
fonoaga he Fono Ekepule Niue e Omonuo he Mahani Fakamooli ne fakakite mai
he Matakupu 21 he Fakatufono-tohi FakavE nai, mo e tau talahauaga ha ha he
Matakupu na to lata ia foki fakalataha mo e tau fakahuihuiaga ke tuga mo e mena
ko e tau talahauaga ha ha i ai kua hagaao ia ke he taha ekepule, ka ko e hagaao
foki ke he Fakatonu Fono.
(6) To maeke he Fakatonu Fono he ha magaaho ni ke fakaoti e haana a
gahua ke he taha tohi he matalima haana mo e tuku atu ke he Fakamau Kupu he
Fono Ekepule Niue, ti ki a toka e ia haana a kotofa –
(a) He huaga atu he Fakatonu Fono fifili foou he magaaho ka fono
fakamua ai e Fono Ekepule he mole atu taha Viliaga Lahi; po ke
(e ) Kaeke kua fakaoti a ia nakai tuai tonuhia ke lata mo e mahani he
viliaga ke moua e tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule; po ke
(i) Kaeke kua eke tuai a ia mo taha tagata fakatu higoa ki ai ke he
viliaga he taha ekepule po ke tau ekepule ma e Fono Ekepule.
(7) Kaeke kua nakai ha ha i ai e Fakatonu Fono he taha fonoaga he Fono
Ekepule, po ke tokanoa ai e kotofaaga he Fakatonu Fono, ko e tau Ekepule he
fonoaga na, ke fifili e lautolu e taha mai ia lautolu, ka e nakai ko e taha Ikipule, ke
takitaki e fonoaga na, a to maeke he Fakatonu Fono pauaki ke liu fakalataha ai, po
ke a to hoko e magaaho ke fifili ai e Fakatonu Fono mo e hu atu ai a ia ke he haana
a tau gahua kotofa he haana kotofaaga.
(8) Kaeke he ha magaaho kua nakai fai fono ai e Fono Ekepule, ko e
Fakatonu Fono, ha kua gagao po ke fano kehe mai i Niue, mo e nakai maeke
fakaku ia ia ke taute e haana a tau gahua, ko e tau gahua ia to maeke ai ke taute ai
he taha Ekepule he Fono, nakai ko e taha Ikipule, kua takitaki ai e fonoaga he
Fono ke lata mo e Vala Kupu (7) he Matakupu nei. Ka molea e tokotaha e Ekepule
kua tutonuhia mo e ataina ke eke e tau gahua he Fakatonu Fono, ko e tau gahua ia
to taute ai he Ekepule ne fakamuiaki e takitaki ke he taha Fono he Fono Ekepule
ke lata mo e vala kupu na.
38 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(9) Kaeke kua kitia ko e nakai fai tagata kua tonuhia ke taute e gahua he
Fakatonu Fono
(a) Kua poaki ai nai ke ui fakamafiti e taha fono he Fono Ekepule, ti ko
e Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue, ke taute e ia e tau gahua
kotofa he Fakatonu Fono, tuga he manako ke eke ai ke lata ke maeke
ai e fonoaga na ke fakahoko, ti ko e tau talahauaga he Matakupu
22(6) he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave, to nakai fakaaoga ai ke he fonoaga
na; po ke
(e ) Kaeke kua tigahau e Fono Ekepule he tuku ke maeke he taha viliaga
lahi ke fakahoko ka e nakai la fakahoko ia e viliaga lahi ia, kua
poaki ai nai pehe ke fakahoko fakamafiti ai e taha fono he tau tagata
ne talahau ko e tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule fakamua to tuku e
Fono Ekepule ke lata mo e viliaga lahi ke fifili taha mai ia lautolu
ke taute e tau gahua he kotofaaga Fakatonu Fono ke he tau magahala
kua nakai maeke ai he Fakatonu Fono kotofa pauaki ke taute e tau
gahua ia, po ke, ke lata mo e magahala tokanoa to liu e Fono Ekepule
foou ke fakahoko e fonoaga fakamua, ti ko e Fakamau Kupu he
Fono Ekepule Niue ke lago ki ai e tau fekau oti kua hagaao ke he
uiaga he taha fono motuhia pihia, mo e ko ia foki ke fakamooli e
fakamauaga he fono hagaao ke he fifiliaga he taha ke taute a tau
gahua he Fakatonu Fono. Ko e tagata ka fifili ke taute e tau gahua
ia to talahau ai pehe, ke lata mo e tau vala kupu (7) mo e (8) he
Matakupu nei, ko ia taha he tau tagata ne kua takitaki e taha fonoaga
he Fono Ekepule.
(10) Ko e tau pepa oti, fakalataha mo e ha fakamooliaga ke he ha Fakatufono
Fakalatalata, ka fakamooli he Fakatonu Fono ke he matalima tohi haana ke lata
mo e tauteaga he haana a matagahua, ki a nakai noa mo e fakamooli ai foki he
Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule ke he haana matalima tohi, ti kaeke ko e tau
pepa kua fakamooli ai he taha Ekepule ne taute e kotofaaga he Fakatonu Fono, ki
a tohi ai fakalataha he fakamooliaga he tau pepa ia ko e pihia e tauteaga.

21 Tau Ekepule ke taute e Omonuo he Mahani Fakamooli

A to kehe ni ke lata mo e gahua ke maeke ai e Matakupu nai ke fakatatai
mo e fifiliaga he Fakatonu Fono, to nakai fai ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue kua
maeke ke fakaata ke nofo po ke vili ai i loto he Fono Ekepule a to taute fakamua e
ia e omonuo na i lalo ki mua he Fakatonu Fono pehe:
Ko au ko,…………………………………….kua omonuo nai au ke he Higoa he Atua Malolo Ue Atu pehe, to mahani fakamooli au mo e fua e mahani pipiki mau mooli ke he Patuiki Fifine (po ke Taane) Lilifu
[ talahau e higoa he Patuiki kua pule ai, tuga he pehe Patuiki Fifine ko Elisapeta ke Uaaki ] mo e Haana a tau hukui mo e tau ohi, ke lata mo e fakatufono-tohi, mo e to taute e au haaku a tau gahua kotofa ko e taha Ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue mo e mahani tonu mo e fakamooli. Ko e mena ia ki a lagomatai mai au, ma Atua na e.

22 Fakaholoaga Gahua he Fono Ekepule Niue

(1) Ko e Fono Ekepule Niue kua poaki nai ke fakalataha ai ke fono ke he
ha mena mo e he ha magaaho kua fifili ki ai he Fakatonu Fono ke lata mo e ole atu
he Palemia ki a ia ke eke pihia mai he taha magaaho kua fifili ke lata mo e mena ia:
Ka e kaeke kua mole atu e 6 e tau faahi tapu mai he fonoaga fakahiku he
Fono Ekepule, ti ko e toko 4 po ke tokologa atu foki e tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule,

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 39

nakai ko lautolu ko e tau Ikipule, to maeke ke ole atu ke he Fakatonu Fono ke kotofa e taha mena mo e magaaho ke fai fono ai e Fono Ekepule, ti ko e Fakatonu Fono to maeke ia ia ke kotofa e mena mo e magaaho ke lata mo e ole ia, ko e magaaho ke nakai tote hifo he 5 e tau aho po ke nakai leva ke molea e 10 e tau aho ka e ai totou e aho ne taute ai e ole.
(2) Ko e Fakatonu Fono kua poaki nai ke takitaki e ia e tau fonoaga takitaha
oti he Fono Ekepule ne kua ha ha i ai a ia.
(3) A to kehe ai ni kaeke kua fakatoka kehe pauaki he Fakatufono-tohi
Fakave nai, ko e tau kupu huhu po ke tau fekau oti kua tuku ki mua he Fono
Ekepule Niue ke fifili ki ai kua poaki ai nai ko e fakamau ke he mena ne fifili ki ai
ke he loga he tau vili he tau Ekepule kua ha ha he fonoaga mo e vili ki ai.
(4) Ka e kehe ni kaeke ko e muitua atu ke he ha fakatufono-tohi, kaeke ko
e fai fakatufono-tohi hagaao ke he fakakaupaaga ke he ha ekepule ke nakai fakaata
ke fai vili kaeke ko e fekau ke he taha mena taute ke he puhala taute maveheaga
tohi ne kua ha ha i ai ko ia ko e ekepule ne fai mena aoga ke moua e ia ha ko e
tauteaga pihia, ko e poaki ha nai ke taute vili e tau ekepule oti ne ha ha i loto he ha
fonoaga he Fono Ekepule ke lata mo e tau fekau oti ne tuku ke vili ki ai.
(5) Ko e Fakatonu Fono po ke taha tagata kua takitaki e fono to nakai fai
vili fakaoti fekau ke eke e ia, ti nakai fai vili pauaki e Fakatonu Fono, ka ko e
ekepule kua takitaki e fono ma e higoa he Fakatonu Fono to fai vili pauaki ke eke
e ia.
(6) A to kehe ke lata mo e Matakupu 20(9) (a) he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, to nakai fai gahua ke taute ai he ha fonoaga he Fono Ekepule Niue kaeke kua ha ha i ai e tau ekepule ne fakalataha atu ke he fonoaga ko e tote hifo he toko 10 a lautolu, totou ki ai foki he numela ia e ha ekepule kua takitaki e fono ma e higoa he Fakatonu Fono.
(7) Ko e tau malolo pule he Fono Ekepule Niue to nakai lauia ai ha kua
pehe ko e taha nofoa ekepule kua tokanoa.
(8) To nakai maeke e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata ke fakamooli ai, a to totou
laga 3 ai i loto he Fono Ekepule.
(9) Ko e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke ha fekau ne kua ha ha i mua he
Fono Ekepule he magaaho ka tuku ai e Fono Ekepule ke lata mo e fakahokoaga he
taha viliaga lahi kua pehe ke fakaoti noa mo e tiaki ai.
(10) Mo e muitua atu ke he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, ko e Fono
Ekepule to maeke ai mai he taha magahala ke he taha magahala ke taute e taha
Tohi He Tau Poakiaga Fakaholoaga Fono ke lata mo e fakatokatokaaga mo e
fakahakohakoaga mitaki he tau fakaholoaga he tau gahua po ke tau fono.

23 Tau Vagahau

(1) Ko e Fakatonu Fono po ke ha ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue to maeke
ke vagahau ai ke he vagahau faka-niue po ke vagahau faka-Peritania :
Ka e ko e poakiaga ke he Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule ke taute e tau
fakatokaaga kua lata, ka ole he Fakatonu Fono, po ke he ha ekepule kua ole ai ke
he Fakatonu Fono, ke fakatoka pehe ko e tau vagahau he Fakatonu Fono po ke ha
vagahau he ha ekepule ke liliu ke he vagahau faka-Peritania po ke liliu ke he
vagahau faka-Niue, ko e mena fe ni kua lauia ai.
(2) Ko e tau Fakatufono Fakalatalata oti kua tuku ki mua he Fono Ekepule
Niue mo e tau Fakatufono-tohi oti kua poaki nai ke tohia ai ke he vagahau faka-
Niue mo e pihia foki ke he vagahau faka-Peritania.
Ka e maeke kaeke ko e Fono Ekepule ne manako, ha ko e taha kupu pulega kua
fakamau, ke fakatoka ni pehe ko e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke Fakatufono­
tohi to maeke ke tohia ai ke he vagahau faka-Niue hokoia po ke vagahau faka-
Peritania hokoia ni.
40 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) Ko e fakamauaga he tau kupu fono i loto he Fono Ekepule po ke i loto he tau Komiti ha ha i ai, kua poaki nai ai ke tohia ai ke he vagahau faka-Niue ti ko e tau fakamauaga pehe na tuga he fakakite mai ai he Tohi He Tau Poakiaga Fakaholoaga Fono he Fono Ekepule po ke ha kua maeke ha ko e taha kupu pulega he Fono Ekepule ke fakatoka ke maeke foki ke tohia ke he vagahau faka-Peritania. (4) Ko e liliuaga ke he vagahau faka-Niue mo e liliuaga ke he vagahau
faka-Peritania he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, a to kehe kaeke ko e muitua ke he vala kupu (5) he Matakupu nai, ko e liliuaga ke he vagahau faka-Niue mo e liliuaga ke he vagahau faka-Peritania he ha fakamauaga he tau kupu fono i loto he Fono Ekepule po ke ha Komiti ha ha i ai mo e ha fakatufono-tohi to maeke ke tatai ni e aoga ha laua :
Ka e, kaeke kua pehe, he ha mena kua kitia tonu ai e nakai fetataiaki he vaha loto
he ha talahauaga ha ha he liliuaga ke he vagahau faka-Niue mo e liliuaga ke he
vagahau faka-Peritania he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, po ke he ha fakamauaga
po ke he ha fakatufono-tohi ne kua ha ha i ai kua tauteute e talahauaga na, to fai
kitekiteaga ke he tau mena oti kua pehe to fakatupu ai e manatu mooli mo e
kakano he talahauaga na.
(5) Ko e ha mena kua lauia ai e ha fakamauaga he tau kupu tutala he Fono
ekepule Niue po ke he ha Komiti kua ha ha i ai, ko e Fono Ekepule to maeke, ha
ko e taha kupu pulega ke fakatoka ai mo e kaeke ko e ha fakatufono-tohi to taute
fakamooli pehe, kaeke kua ha ha i ai e ha fekehekeheaki he vaha loto he liliuaga
ke he vagahau faka-Niue mo e liliuaga ke he vagahau faka-Peritania he ha
fakamauaga pehe na po ke ha fakatufono-tohi, to taha ni e liliuaga ka talahau ko
e mooli mo e tonu, ko e vagahau faka-Niue po ke liliuaga ke he vagahau faka-
Peritania ke maeke ke fakatumau ki ai.

24 Tau mena ataina ki ai e Fono Ekepule Niue mo e tau ekepule ha ha i ai

(1) Ko e malolo mo e tonu ha ha i ai he ha tauteaga i loto he Fono Ekepule
Niue, po ke i loto he ha Komiti ha ha i ai, mo e malolo he ha tohi fakamooli kua foaki atu he Fakatonu Fono i lalo he Matakupu 34 po ke Matakupu 35 ha ha he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, to nakai maeke ke fai kupu huhu ki ai e ha Fakafiliaga. (2) To nakai maeke he Fakatonu Fono, po ke ha ekepule, po ke ha tagata
gahua he Fono Ekepule Niue kua tuku atu ki ai e tau malolo pule ke fakatonutonu e fakaholoaga po ke mahani he tauteaga he tau gahua, po ke levekiaga he puhala hako, to nakai lauia ai, ha ko e tauteaga e ia he tau malolo pule na, ke he ha Fakafiliaga.
(3) To nakai maeke he Fakatonu Fono, po ke ha ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue ne kua ha ha i ai e tonuhia ke vagahau ai i loto he fono ke lata mo e ha tauteaga he fono, ke lauia he ha Fakafiliaga hagaao ke he ha mena kua talahau ai po ke ha viliaga kua taute e ia i loto he Fono Ekepule po ke ha Komiti ha ha i ai. (4) To nakai fai tagata ke lauia ai he ha tauteaga i loto he ha Fakafiliaga
kaeke ko e taha mena kua hagaao ke he ha fakailoaga lolomi he lomiaga fakapuloa i lalo he malolo pule he Fono Ekepule Niue he ha fakailoaga, he ha pepa, he viliaga po ke ha tutalaaga ke he mahani he fono.
(5) Mo e muitua atu ke he Matakupu nai, ko e tau mena ataina ki ai e Fono Ekepule Niue mo e tau Komiti ha ha i ai mo e tau mena ataina ki ai e tau ekepule mo e Fakatonu Fono he Fono Ekepule mo e tau tagata kua fakaataina ke vagahau i loto he tau Fonoaga, to fakamau ia ke he taha Fakatufono-tohi, ti ko e ha Fakatufono-tohi pihia to maeke ai, ka e kehe ai ni ka lauia ai ha mena he Matakupu
31 he Fakatufono Fakave nai, ke fakakite fakatonu e tau holifono hagaao ke he
holia he ataina po ke ai fakalilifu ke he Fono Ekepule, mo e maeke ai ke taute e tau
fakatokaaga ke lata mo e fakalilifuaga mo e fakahala he tau holifono pehe na i loto
he Fakafiliaga Lahi ka e nakai ko e ha puhala kehe.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 41

25 Palepale he Palemia, Tau Ikipule ne toe tau tau ekepule ne toe he Fono

Ekepule Niue mo e Fakatonu Fono

(1) Ko e kau pule gahua Fakatufono Niue to maeke, mai he taha magahala
ke he taha magahala, mo e kua poaki ai ke, kaeke kua ha ha i ai e taha hikihikiaga
he tau tutuaga he tau palepale he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue, ke fakailoa mo e
fai talahauaga pulega ke he Fono Ekepule ke lata mo e tau tutuaga he tau palepale
mo e falu a palepale kua lata ke moua ai he Palemia, tau Ikipule ne toe, tau ekepule
he Fono Ekepule ka e nakai ko e tau Ikipule, mo e Fakatonu Fono.
(2) Ko e Palemia mo e tau Ikipule ne toe, tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule
Niue ne nakai ko e tau Ikipule, mo e Fakatonu Fono kua pehe to maeke ke moua
e lautolu e tau palepale, tau palepale lafi ki luga mo e falu a mena kehekehe ne
kua lata ke moua ha ko e tau kotofaaga ia ke tuga ka fakakite mai ai he taha
Fakatufono-tohi.
(3) Kaeke, ha ko e manatu he Fakatonu Fono, ko e ha Fakatufono
Fakalatalata, po ke ha fakahuiaga ke he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata, kua hagaao
ke he taha mena kua hagaao ki ai e Matakupu nai, ti ko e Fakatufono Fakalatalata
na, po ke fakahuiaga na, to nakai maeke ke tuku ki mua he fono a to­
(a) Ha ha i ai i mua he Fono Ekepule e taha fakailoaaga mo e talahauaga
pulega mai he Kau Pule Gahua Fakatufono Niue ke lata mo e
Matakupu nai, mo e
(e ) Ko e kakano he kupu ne talahau ai i loto he Fakatufono Fakalatalata
na, po ke fakahuiaga na, ke he manatu he Fakatonu Fono, kua
hagaao tatai ni mo e tau mena kua fifili ki ai he fakailoaaga he Kau
Pule Gahua mo e tau talahauaga pulega he Kau ha ha i ai.

26 Tukuaga he Fono Ekepule Niue

(1) Ko e Fakatonu Fono kua poaki nai ki a ia, ke he taha fakailoaga i loto he
Kasete Niue, ke tuku e Fono Ekepule Niue ka e fakahoko taha viliaga lahi kaeke –
(a) Kua katoa ai e 3 e tau tau mai he aho ne taute ai e viliaga lahi, kaeke
kua nakai la tuku ai fakamua to hoko ke he 3 e tau tau ia;
(e) mai he aho ne hoko ai e viliaga lahi kua mole ki tua, kaeke kua
manako pihia ki ai e Palemia;
(i) Kaeke, ha ko e muitua ke he Matakupu 6 (3) he Fakatufono-tohi
Fakave nai, ko e Palemia ne ole ki a ia ke tuku e Fono Ekepule ka e
fakahoko taha viliaga lahi;
(o) Kua taute ai e taha viliaga foou he Palemia ke lata mo e Matakupu
5 (4) he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai, ti nakai moua mai he viliaga
foou na, e tuaga aoga po ke fai kakano ke lata mo e vala kupu na.
(2) Ko e poaki a nai ke eke ai e taha viliaga lahi ke lata mo e mouaaga he
tau ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue he ha magaaho, ke nakai tote hifo ai he 4 e tau
faahi tapu po ke molea ai e 6 e tau faahi tapu he mole atu e aho ne tuku ai e Fono
Ekepule, tuga he poaki ai nei ke he Fakatonu Fono, ha ko e ole he Palemia, ke
kotofa, po ke kaeke ko e Palemia kua nakai taute ai e ia e ha ole pehe na he ha
magaaho to molea ai ko e 7 e tau aho mai he aho ne tuku ai e Fono Ekepule, tuga
he taute ai he Fakatonu Fono ke he haana ni a manatu, ke kotofa ai, ke he taha
fakailoaaga i loto he Kasete Niue.
42 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

27 Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue

(1) To ha ha i ai e taha tagata gahua he kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue ke
fakahigoa ai ko e Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue, ko ia kua poaki nai ki ai
ke leveki mo e fua e tau gahua ke –
(a) Fakatokatoka e tau gahua mo e leveki e tau fakamauaga he tau
tutalaaga mo e toka e tau fakamauaga he tau mena tutala he Fono
Ekepule Niue; mo e
(e ) Fakatokatoka, ke lata mo e fakamooli matalima tohi he tau tohi mo
e tuku atu e tau tohi fakamooli mai he Fakatonu Fono kaeke ko e
ha magaaho kua lata ke fai higoa fakamooli po ke ha fakamooliaga
kua lata ke eke he Fakatonu Fono ke lata mo e ha talahauaga he
Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nai po ke ha fakatufono-tohi, mo e leveki e
tau pepa oti mo e tau tohi fakamooli kua fakamooli ai po ke foaki.
(2) Ko e Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue kua poaki nai ki a ia ke eke
mo e mahani kua tonu ki mua he Fakatonu Fono mo e ke he tau ekepule he Fono
Ekepule e tau gahua fakamau mena oti mo e falu a gahua ke tuga ka manako ki ai.

Ko e Talagaaga he Tau Fakatufono-tohi

28 Malolo kotofa ke taute fakatufono-tohi

(1) Ka e muitua ke he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, maeke e Fono Ekepule
Niue ke taute Fakatufono-tohi ma e fakatupuaga he mafola, holo tonuhia mo e
mitaki he Fakatufono ma Niue.
(2) Ko e malolo kotofa he Fono Ekepule Niue kua maeke ke hokotia ia foki
ke fakaholo atu e taute fakatufono-tohi ke lata mo e falu a mena i fafo ha Niue;
pehe e mena ia, ko e tau fakatufono-tohi ke lauia po ke hagaao atu ke he ha tagata
po ke ha mena i fafo ha Niue po ke ha mena kua taute i fafo ha Niue.
(3) Mo e nakai fakakaupa e tau malolo kotofa katoa ne toka i loto he
Matakupu nei, ko e tau malolo kotofa ia to hokotia atu foki ke he malolo ke
moumou po ke utakehe, po ke fakahui po ke fakafoou po ke lalafi ki luga, ke lata
mo Niue, e ha Fakatufono-tohi ha ne fakagahua ai i Niue po kua hagaao tonu ki
Niue.
(4) A to kehe ai ni kaeke ko e nakai muitua ke he taha mena he Fakatufono­ tohi Fakave nai, nakai maeke e ha Fakatufono-tohi ke pehe kua nakai aoga ha ko e nakai o tatai mo e tau fakatufono-tohi ne fakagahua i Niue.

29 Tukuaga he tau Fakatufono Fakalatalata mo e falu mena kehekehe ki loto he Fono Ekepule Niue

Ka nakai kehe mai mo e Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei po ke tau Poakiaga Fakaholoaga Fono he Fono Ekepule Niue, maeke e ha Ekepule he Fono Ekepule ke tuku e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke ha tohi kupu pulega ke fakatutala fetoko ki ai, po ke tuku e ha ole ke he Fono Ekepule, ko e tau mena ia to pulega ni ki ai mo e taute ai e taha fakaotiaga ke lata mo e tau Poakiaga Fakaholoaga Fono.

30 Tau fakakaupaaga pauaki ke lata mo e tau vahega fekau faka Tupe

A to kehe ai ni kaeke ko e moua mai ha ko e pulega po ke taliaaga he
Palemia, po ke taha Ikipule ne eke pihia ha ko e taute ma e higoa he kotofaaga he
Palemia, to nakai maeke e Fono Ekepule Niue ke fai fifiliaga ke he ha Fakatufono
Fakalatalata (lafi ki ai e ha fakahuiaga ke he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata) kaeke,
kua kitia he Fakatonu Fono kua lauia ai ha fakaaoga unuhake ki luga he ha tupe
he tau tupe fafati ke totogi i Niue po ke utakehe, po ke hiki, po ke ka pehE ai ko e
tau fafati tukuhau, fakahala tupe, po ke ha tupe tukuhau fafati ke totogi he tau
vahega kehekehe a to kehe ni kaeke ko e tukuhifo ki lalo he ha mena totogi he tau
mena kehekehe.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 43

31 (Uta Kehe)

32 Tau fakatokaaga fifili pauaki hagaao ke he tau mena kua lauia ai e Kau

Gahua Fakatufono Niue

(1) To nakai maeke he Fono Ekepule Niue ke fakatutala e ha Fakatufono
Fakalatalata po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata ke he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata he
mole e tukuatuaga fakamua ke he Fono kaeke, ke he manatu he Fakatonu Fono,
ko e Fakatufono Fakalatalata na po ke fakahuiaga na, kua fai fakatokaaga ke lauia
ai e tau mena nai –
(a) Tau totogi, tau tupe lafi ki luga, tau hatakiaga, tau puhala ke takitaki
aki, po ke tau puhala ke lata mo e fakaholoaga he gahua he Kau
Gahua Fakatufono Niue, po ke
(e ) Tau kotofaaga, fakaholo hake he tau kotofaaga, hikihikiaga he tau
kotofaaga, faka okioki mo e gahua, utakehe e gahua, fakaoti fakaku
e gahua, mo e fakaotiaga he kotofaaga ha lautolu mai he Kau Gahua
Fakatufono Niue, lafi ki ai e liu kikite, po ke tau ole liu fifili, hagaao
ia ke he mena kua lauia ai a to moua ki mua he Fono Ekepule e taha
fakailoaaga talahauaga, mai he Kau Pule Gahua Fakatufono Niue
ha ko e muitua ke he Matakupu nei, hagaao ke he tonuhia he mahani
faka-fakatufono, tonuhia he mahani faka-fakatufono-tohi fakave
po ke ha fakatokaaga faka fakatufono kua lauia ai he Fakatufono
Fakalatalata, po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata.
(2) Kaeke, ha ko e muitua ke he Matakupu nai, kua fifili e Fono Ekepule
ha ko e tauteaga ke he taha kupu pulega kua talia ke ole ke he Kau Pule Gahua
Fakatufono Niue ke fai fakailoaaga talahauaga hagaao ke he taha Fakatufono
Fakalatalata, po ke taha fakahuiaga fakalatalata, ko e poaki nai ke he Fakatonu
Fono ke kitia kua fakafano ke he Kau Pule Gahua Fakatufono Niue e taha lagaki
he kupu pulega na, fakalataha mo e taha talahauaga fakamaamaaga he tutalaaga
he Fono Ekepule he mena na, fakalataha mo e taha lagaki he Fakatufono
Fakalatalata na, po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata ke he Fakatufono Fakalatalata
kua hagaao ki ai; ka e kaeke kua nakai pihia e fifiliaga he Fono Ekepule, ko e
Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke fakahuiaga fakalatalata na, kua pehe ai kua nakai
fai aoga ti ki a tiaki ai.
(3) Kaeke, ha ko e muitua ke he Matakupu nei, ke moua he Fono Ekepule
e fakailoaaga mai he kau Pule Gahua Fakatufono Niue hagaao ke he Fakatufono
Fakalatalata, po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata ke he he Fakatufono Fakalatalata, ti
moua mai ai ha ko e mena ia e ha fakafoouaga he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata kua
tuku atu, ko e talahauaga he Matakupu nai kua nakai lata ke liu ui atu foki ke he
kau Pule Gahua ke liu fai talahauaga foki, a to kehe ni ka manatu e Fakatonu
Fono kua lauia ai e talahauaga tonuhia ke he mahani faka-fakatufono, tonuhia he
mahani faka fakatufono-tohi fakave, po ke ha fakatokaaga faka fakatufono ka e
nakai la moua mai he oleaga fakamua ke he Kau ia e taha fakailoaaga kua hagaao
tonu ke he taha lauiaaga kua laga mai he fakafoouaga ia.
44 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

33

Niue

Tau tauteaga fifili pauaki ma e tau tauteaga kua lauia ai e tau vala kelekele

(1) Ko e Fono Ekepule Niue to nakai maeke ke fakatutala e ha Fakatufono
Fakalatalata, po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata ke he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata ka mole e tukuaga fakamua ke he Fono kaeke kua manatu e Fakatonu Fono pehe ko e Fakatufono Fakalatalata, po ke fakahuiaga fakalatalata kua lauia ai e tau fakatokatokaaga ke he tau mena nai –
(a) Ko e fakaveaga he tonuhia ke he ha kelekele Niue; po ke
(e) Ko e foakiaga kua kehe he ha kelekele Niue; po ke
(i) Ko e fakatauaga, uta, po ke ha puhala kehe foki ke moua ai ha
kelekele Niue ke lata mo e ha fakaaogaaga ma e tau tagata oti
a to moua ki mua he Fono Ekepule e ha fakailoaaga ne taute ai he taha Kau
Kumikumi ne ha ha i ai e tau malolo kotofa ke ui atu ke he tau fakamooli mo e ke
moua e tau talahauaga tuga kua ha ha i ai ke he Kau Kumikumi ha ko e tau
fakamauaga fakatufono-tohi ke lata mo e talahauaga faka fakatufono, po ke tonuhia
he mahani faka fakatufono-tohi fakaveaga, po ke ha fakatokaaga faka fakatufono,
kaeke kua fai lauiaaga e tau vahega mena pihia i loto he Fakatufono Fakalatalata,
po ke fakahuiaga fakalatalata na.
(2) Kaeke, ke he taha kupu fakamau he Fono Ekepule kua fifili, hagaao ke
he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata kua lauia ai e
Matakupu nei, kua lata ke fai kumikumi ki ai e taha Kau Kumikumi ke lata mo e
Matakupu nei, ko e poaki nai ke he Fono he tau Ikipule ke fakamafiti ke fifili ko e
lata nakai, ti taute e puhala ke gahua ai ke lata mo e manako he Fono Ekepule kua
fakamau ki ai; ka e kaeke kua nakai muitua e Fono Ekepule ke he puhala ia hagaao
ke he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke ha fakahuiaga, to tiaki ai e Fakatufono
Fakalatalata po ke fakahuiaga na mo e talahau ai kua nakai aoga e mena ia.
(3) Ko e ha magaaho kua fai talahauaga fakamau ai e Fono Ekepule ke lata
mo e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata, ha ko e muitua
ke he Matakupu nei, kua lata ke pulega po ke kua pehe e hagaaoaga ke kumikumi
ki ai e taha Kau Kumikumi ke lata mo e Matakupu nei –
(a) To maeke ke he fifiliaga he Fono he tau Ikipule ke fakatu e taha
Kau Kumikumi mo e tuku atu ke he kau ia e tau talahauaga fakave
ke lata mo e gahua, po ke taute e falu a hikihikiaga kua tonuhia ki
ai ke he tau fakaveaga ke lata mo e gahua he Kau Kumikumi ne
fakatu tuai ke lata mo e kumikumiaga ke he mena kua lauia ai e ha
fakaveaga he tau kelekele Niue; ti ko e poakiaga nai kua lago ke he
Palemia ke fakailoa atu mafiti ke he Fono Ekepule e ha
fakatokatokaaga ne taute he Fono he tau Ikipule ke fakatautonu
aki e tau talahauaga fakamau ke he fifiliaga he Fono Ekepule; mo e
(e ) Ka moua mai e talahauaga ia mai he Fono he tau Ekepule, ko e
poaki nai kua lago ke he Fakatonu Fono ke fakafano ke he Kau
Kumikumi ne fakatu he Fono he tau Ikipule ke lata mo e gahua kua
poaki ki ai ke maeke ke moua mai e taha talahauaga ke he
Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke he fakahuiaga fakalatalata hagaao
ke he talahauaga fakamau he Fono Ekepule, e taha lagaki he
talahauaga fakamau he Fono Ekepule, lafi ki ai e taha lagaki he
Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke he lagaki he fakahuiaga fakalatalata
ke he Fakatufono Fakalatalata kua lauia ai, ti ko e Kau Kumikumi,
ke lata mo e Matakupu nei, ne kua poaki nai ke taute e fakailoaaga
mo e tuku atu ai ke he Fono Ekepule.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 45

(4) Kaeke, ha ko e muitua ke he Matakupu nei, kua moua ai he Fono Ekepule e fakailoaaga mai he Kau Kumikumi hagaao ke he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke ha fakahuiaga fakalatalata ke he ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata ti pehe kua moua mai ai e taha fakafoouaga po ke ha fakahuiaga fakafoou, ti pehe ai kua nakai lauia ke he kupu poaki ne pehe ke moua mai taha talahauaga he Kau Kumikumi, a to kehe ni ka manatu e Fakatonu Fono kua lauia ai e ha talahauaga kua tonuhia ke he mahani hako faka-fakatufono, tonuhia ke he mahani hako faka fakatufono-tohi fakave po ke ha fakatokaaga faka fakatufono, kaeke kua nakai hokotia e talahauaga fakamua he fakailoaaga mai he Kau Kumikumi ke he mena ia ne manatu e Fakatonu Fono ki ai.
(5) Ha he Matakupu nei ko e –
“Foakiaga kua Kehe”, hagaao ke he tau kelekele Niue, ko e haana kakano
ko e ha vala fonua fakatoka kehe ha ko e foakiaga hiki, fakafua tupe,
foaki fakalofa, foaki nofo totogi, foaki laiseni, foaki ha ko e tonuhia ke
fakaaoga he falu, foaki ke moua e polofita, foaki fakamaveheaga
kaitalofa, foaki faka totogi kaitalofa, lauia ha kua nakai tokanoa e
kelekele, foaki fai falanakiaga ke leveki ma e taha po ke ha puhala foaki
kehe foki ni ko e katoatoa po ke fai fakakaupa, ha ko e faka –fakatufono
po ke talahau ko e tonuhia; lafi ai foki pihia kaeke ko e pulega faka­
konotuleke ke foaki kua kehe; mo e lafi ki ai e ha liuakiaga po ke
hikihikiaga he ha vala kelekele po ke fakakehekeheaga he ha foaki
totogi, foaki laiseni, foaki ma e kaitalofa po ke foaki moua polofita po
ke ha foaki fakakehe ke lata mo e foakiaga he ha vala kelekele ke he ha
puhala kua fakakite ai nei:
“Fakaveaga he tau vala kelekele ke he mahani fakamotu” ko e kakano ko e
fakamauaga ke lata ia mo e mahani fakamotu ke he tonuhia he fonua
pihia mo e fakaaogaaga he tau vala kelekele i Niue:
“Tau Kelekele Niue”, kakano ko e tau vala kelekele Niue ne fakave ke he
Foufou he Patuiki kua talahau ko e Fakatufono ka e toka ke he pule he
tau Niue ke lata mo e mahani mo e fakaaogaaga fakamotu; lafi ki ai e
ha fonua kua tonuhia mai he foakiaga he Fakatufono to hoko e aho 1 ia
Apelila 1916 mo e ha fonua Niue kua fakahigoa ai ko e tau fonua kua
tohi ke he higoa tagata kua ha ha i ai e poakiaga he ha Fakafiliaga to
hoko e aho 1 ia Novema 1969.

34 Ko e magaaho ka fakamooli ai e tau Fakatufono Fakalatalata ke eke mo tau Fakatufono-tohi

(1) A to kehe ni kaeke ko e talahauaga he Matakupu 35 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, hagaao ke he tau mena kua tonuhia ke he Matakupu ia, to maeke ni e tau Fakatufono Fakalatalata ke eke mo Fakatufono-tohi, kaeke, mo e kaeke ni –
(a) Kua talia ai he Fono Ekepule Niue; mo e
(e) Kua tonuhia ke he manatu he Fakatonu Fono kua talia mo e muitua
ke he tau fakatokaaga he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei mo e tau
Poakiaga Fakave ma e Fakaholoaga Fono he Fono Ekepule, ti kua
fakamooli ai ke he matalima tohi haana i mua he Fakamau Kupu
he Fono Ekepule Niue, e taha fakamooliaga ki loto he taha lagaki
he Fakatufono Fakalatalata mo e fakamailoga aki e Fakamailoga a
Niue, mo e pehe kua muitua e tauteaga ke he puhala ne talahau he
Matakupu nei ke muitua ki ai ti tohia ai e aho ne fakamooli mo e
fakamailoga ai; mo e
46 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(i) Kua fakamooli foki he Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue ke he matalima tohi haana i mua he Fakatonu Fono e lagaki he Fakatufono Fakalatalata na ne fakamooli he Fakatonu Fono ne toka ai e fakamooliaga kua talahau ai.
(2) Ko e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata kua eke mo fakatufono-tohi ke tuga mo e tau talahauaga he Matakupu nei, to eke ia mo Fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule Niue.
(3) A to kehe ni ka fakakite tonu i loto he ha Fakatufono-tohi, ko e tau Fakatufono-tohi oti ke kamata fakagahua ai Niue he aho ne fakamooli matalima ai mo e tuku aki ai e fakamailoga a Niue.

35 Malolo kotofa he Fono Ekepule Niue ke uta kehe po ke fakahui e

Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei

(1) Ko e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata ke uta kehe po ke fakahui, po ke
fakafoou, po ke fakalaulahi, e ha Matakupu po ke ha vala kupu he Matapatu
Fakatufono-tohi Fakave a Niue 1974, po ke Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, po ke
taute ai ha fakatokaaga kua nakai fetataiaki mo e ha talahauaga na, to maeke ni ke
eke ai mo fakatufono-tohi, ka eke, mo e ka eke hokoia ni –
(a) Kua talia ai he Fono Ekepule ke he puhala kua muitua ke he tau
fakatokaaga nai;
(i) He totouaga fakahiku mo e totouaga to hoko e totouaga ia he
ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata, kua moua e tau vili talia ke he
numela katoa kua nakai tote hifo he ua e mena ke tolu aki he
tau numela Ekepule katoatoa he Fono Ekepule tuga ne talahau
ai he Matakupu 16(2) (b) he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei; mo e
(ii) Ko e vili ke eke ke lata mo e totou fakahiku ki a nakai taute a to
Katoa e 13 e tau faahi tapu he mole, ka e nakai lafi ki ai e aho ne
eke ai ke he vili ke lata mo e aho totouaga ne taute to hoko e
totouaga fakahiku; mo e
(e) Kua oti ia ti kua tuku atu ai ke he viliaga, kua taute ai ke he puhala
fakatoka faka-fakatufono-tohi, he tau tagata he magaaho he viliaga
na kua tonuhia ke vili, ko e tau tagata vili he viliaga lahi he tau
Ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue, ti ha ha he viliaga na e omoiaga
talia
(i) Kaeke ko e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata kua utakehe po ke
fakahui po ke fakafoou po ke fakalaulahi e taha he tau
fakaveaga he tau Matakupu 2 ke he 9 he Matapatu Fakatufono­
tohi Fakave a Niue 1974 po ke tau Matakupu 1 mo e 69 he
Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, po ke Matakupu nei, kua lata ke
hokotia ke he ua e mena ke tolu aki e loga he tau vili hako ne
vili; mo e
(ii) Kaeke ko e tau mena ke he ne nakai talahau he vala kupu 35(1)
(b) (i) ti muitua ni ke he loga he tau vili hako ne moua; mo e
(i) Kaeke kua talia he Fakatonu Fono pehe kua fakamooli tuai ke he
tau puhala kua muitua ke lata mo e Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei mo
e Tau Poakiaga Fakave ma e Fakaholoaga Fono he Fono Ekepule
Niue, ti fakamooli he Fakatonu Fono taha lagaki he Fakatufono
Fakalatalata e taha talahauaga fakamooli kua talahau ai pehe kua
muitua e tauteaga ke he talahauaga he Matakupu nei, mo e kua eke
ai e ia pihia ki mua he Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue ke he
matalima tohi haana e tohi fakamooli na, ti fakamau fakamailoga e
lagaki na aki e Fakamailoga a Niue mo e tohi ai i luga e aho ne
fakamooli mo e fakamau fakamailoga ai; mo e

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 47

(o) Ko e Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule Niue, kua eke, i mua he Fakatonu Fono, e fakamooli foki ke he matalima tohi haana e talahauaga fakamooli i loto he lagaki na he Fakatufono Fakalatalata.
(2) Ko e ha Fakatufono Fakalatalata kua eke mo fakatufono-tohi ke lata mo e tau talahauaga he Matakupu nai to talahau mo e totou ai ko e taha vala he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei mo e maeke ai ke talahau ko e fakahuiaga faka fakatufono-tohi fakave.
(3) A to ke he ni ka talahau pauaki i loto, ko e fakahuiaga faka fakatufono­ tohi fakave to kamata fakagahua ai he aho ne taute ai e talahauaga fakamooli mo e fakamau fakamailoga ai.

36 Nakai maeke e Fono Ekepule (Palemene) Niu Silani ke talaga e tau fakatufono-tohi ma Niue, mo e nakai maeke ke fakagahua e ha la fono Niu Silani a to moua e talia ki ai

(1) To nakai maeke e ha Fakatufono-tohi, po ke ha fakatokaaga he ha Fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule (Palemene) Niu Silani ne fakamooli ai he aho, po ke he ha aho kua mole e Aho Fakatokatokaaga he Pule Fakamotu, ke pehe kua maeke ke hokotia e fakaaogaaga ki Niue, po ke pehe kua eke ko e taha vala he fakatufono-tohi a Niue, a to pehe ai –
(a) Ko e fakamooliaga he Fakatufono-tohi po ke taha tauteaga he ha fakatokaaga na , ke lata ke hokotia e fakaaogaaga ki Niue, kua oti tuai he ole fakamua atu ki ai mo e talia ha ko e taha kupu pulega fakamau he Fono Ekepule Niue ke eke pihia; mo e
(e ) Kua oti tuai he talahau fakamahino i loto he ha Fakatufono-tohi
pihia kua pehe ko e Fono Ekepule Niue kua ole atu tuai mo e talia
ki ai ke eke pihia ke lata mo e talagaaga he Fakatufono-tohi na po
ke he fakatokaaga kua ha ha i ai.
(2) To nakai fai fakatufono lafi ne kua taute ai he mole e Aho
Fakakatoatoaaga he Pule Fakamotu, ha ko e muitua ke he Fakatufono-tohi he
Fono Ekepule (Palemene) a Niu Silani, kua maeke ke fakaaoga ki Niue, po ke eke
mo taha vala he tau Fakatufono-tohi a Niue, a to pehe ai –
(a) He aho ka taute ai, ko e Fakatufono-tohi ne moua mai ai e ataina po
ke hagaaoaga ke he talagaaga he fakatufono lafi ko e mena fita ni e
fakatufono-tohi ia he totou ko e taha vala he tau fakatufono-tohi a
Niue; mo e
(e) Ko e fakaaogaaga ki Niue he fakatufono lafi, ko e mena ole mo e
talia fakamua ki ai e Fono he tau Ikipule a Niue; mo e
(i) Kua fakailoa fakamahino ki ai i loto na, pehe, ko e fakatufono lafi
na ne ole mo e talia ki ai e Fono he tau Ikipule a Niue ke lata mo e
tauteaga na.
(3) Koe ha Fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule (Palemene) Niu Silani kua
fakaaoga ki Niue ha ko e tauteaga he Matakupu nei to tatai e fakagahuaaga mo e
haana a aoga ke tuga ni ko e fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule Niue.
(4) Ha ha he Matakupu nei e Kupu, ‘fakatufono lafi” ko e kakano pehe ko
e ha Poakiaga he Kanesila, Fakapuloaaga, tau poakiaga-tohi, tau la fono-tohi mo
e falu a fakatufono lafi.
48 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
VALA III FAKAFILIAGA

Fakafiliaga Lahi ha Niue

37 Ko e Fakatuaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi

(1) To ha ha i ai e fakamauaga he fakafiliaga ke fakahigoa ko e Fakafiliaga
Lahi ha Niue, ke fakagahuahua e tau fifiliaga tonu i Niue.
(2) A to ke he ai ni, ke tuga ne tohia ai i loto he Tohi Fakave nei po ke mata
fakatufono, ko e Fakafiliaga Lahi ke ha ha i ai katoatoa he tau fakagahuahuaaga
he tau fakafiliaga kua aofia ai e tau (fakafiliaga holifono ke he tau mata fakatufono,
fakafiliaga tonuhia faka-tagata mo e fakafiliaga kelekele) ke maeke ai ke
fakagahuahua e tau fakatufono i Niue.
(3) To vevehe 3 pehe nai e Fakafiliaga Lahi –
(a) Fakafiliaga ha ko e tonuhia he tagata;
(b) Fakafiliaga holifono ke he tau fakatufono;
(c) Fakafiliaga kelekele.
(4) To maeke he Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi ke fakaaoga e ha malolo fakafiliaga mo e ha malolo pule ha ha ia ia ke he ha fakafiliaga ne tolu.
(5) Muitua ke he (1), (2), (3), mo e (4) he Matakupu nai mo e Matakupu 38, ko e tau Iki Fakafili taki toko taha he Fakafiliaga Lahi, po ke toko 2 po ke tokologa atu foki, maeke ia lautolu ia he ha magaaho i Niue po ke i fafo i Niue ke fakaaoga e tau malolo pule he Fakafiliaga Lahi.

38 Malolo Pule Fakafiliaga he tau La Fakafiliaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi

(1) Ko e tau La Fakafiliaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi ke fakanogonogo mo e fifili
fakamitaki –
(a) E tau fakafiliaga ke tuga mo e tau poakiaga he ha fakatufono tohi,
ke muitua mo e fifili fakamitaki;
(e) Ko e falu a fakafiliaga pihia mai he taha magahala ke he taha
magahala ke toka ke he fifiliaga he Iki Fakafili Lahi ke he taha vala
ni he fifiliaga po ke fakafiliaga katoa, po ke ha fakafiliaga taute
fakamahao, po ke ha vahega fakafiliaga.
(2) To ha ha he Fakafiliaga Kelekele e tau malolo fakafiliaga oti mo e, tau
malolo pule oti ke he ha fekau kelekele, ko e tau fekau ia ne tutupu to hoko e
kamataaga he Matakupu nai ka e nakai la fai tauteaga ia ki loto he Fakafiliaga
Kelekele ha Niue, ko e mena ia to maeke foki ke moua e falu malolo fakafiliaga
pihia ke fakafili e tau fekau nai ka foaki atu he fakatufono tohi.

39 Tau Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi

(1) To ha ha i ai he Fakafiliaga Lahi toko taha po ke tokologa e tau Iki
Fakafili, lautolu oti ia to fifili ai i lalo hifo he malolo he tau poakiaga he Tohi
Fakave nei.
(2) Kaeke ke tokotaha ni e Iki Fakafili ka fifili ko ia ni ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi
ha Niue, ka e, kaeke ke tokologa ka fifili taha mai ia lautolu ia ka fifili ke eke mo
Iki Fakafili Lahi ha Niue.
(3) To nakai fai tagata ke moua e kotofaaga ko e Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga
Lahi i lalo hifo he Matakupu nai, a to moua fakamua e ia e taha tohi paase tuga ne
talahau ai he Tohi Fakave nei mo e tohia ai i loto he mata fakatufono tohi.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 49

40 Hukui Iki Fakafili Lahi he Fakafiliaga Lahi

Kaeke ke tokanoa ha pu gahua he Ofisa he Iki Fakafili Lahi, po ke ka kitia
ai kua fai kakano aoga ati kua nakai maeke ai he Iki Fakafili Lahi ke taute haana
tau gahua kotofa, ka ko e tau gahua kotofa ia na maeke foki ke taute he taha Iki
Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi, ti kaeke ko e mena maeke he falu Iki Fakafili foki ke
taute e tau gahua kotofa ia, koe mena ia ko e Iki Fakafili ne kua leva haana gahua
ke he kotofaaga Iki Fakafili ko ia ka lago ki ai e kotofaaga Hukui Iki Fakafili Lahi
a to fifili mo e kotofa ai e Iki Fakafili Lahi foou, po ke, a to maeke he Iki Fakafili
Lahi ke liu taute haana tau gahua kotofa.

41 Tau Iki Fakafili nakai gahua mau

To maeke he Fono Ekepule he ha magaaho ke fifili mo e kotofa ai ha tagata
mo e nakai fai kaupaaga e tau tau moui ne kitia kua lata tonu mo e kotofaaga he
Iki Fakafili Lahi, po ke taha Iki Fakafili ke moua e kotofaaga ia ke nakai molea e
taha tau tuga ne tohia ai he tohi kotofaaga gahua.

Fifiliaga, leva he nofo he kotofaaga, mo e tau totogi he tau Iki Fakafili.

42 Fifiliaga he tau Iki Fakafili

Ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi mo e falu Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi to fifili ni ke
he puhala nai:
(a) Ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi he Fakafiliaga Lahi to fifili ai he Kavana Lahi,
to taute e fifiliaga ia ha ko e taliaaga mai he Fono Ikipule mo e
omoiaga he Palemia;
(e) Ko e Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi to fifili ai he Kavana Lahi, to
taute e fifiliaga ia ha ko e taliaaga mai he Fono Ikipule ma e omoiaga
he Iki Fakafili Lahi he Fakafiliaga Lahi mo e Ikipule he Faahi Fakafili.

43 Leva he nofo he kotofaaga Iki Fakafili

(1) To kehe ni kaeke ko e kotofaaga fifili i lalo hifo he Matakupu 41, ha kua
talahau pehe e matakupu ia nakai fai tagata ne kua katoa e 68 e tau tau he moui ke
fifili ke he kotofaaga nai, po ke fakatumau ke he kotofaaga ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi
po ke taha Iki Fakafili foki he Fakafiliaga Lahi.
(2) To nakai fai fifiliaga ke pehe kua nakai tonu ka taute he Iki Fakafili lahi
po ke taha Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi he tau magaaho ka taute ai e ia haana
tau gahua kotofa, pete ni ke pehe kua hoko tuai haana tau tau ke fakaoti ai moe
gahua tuga ne talahau he Matakupu nai, po ke haana tau tau kotofa kua oti tuai.
(3) Ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi po ke taha Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi maeke
ia ia ke tohi ke he haana matalima tohi e haana tohi ke fakaoti moe kotofaaga, tohi
atu ke he Kavana Lahi.

44 Tau totogi he tau Iki Fakafili

(1) Ko e tau totogi he Iki Fakafili Lahi mo e falu Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga
Lahi to muitua ni ke he Fakatufono-tohi, mo e to totogi mai he Tokaaga Tupe he
Fakatufono Niue.
(2) Ko e tau totogi he tau Iki Fakafili ia to nakai tuku hifo he ha magaaho he
nonofo ai a lautolu he tau kotofaaga, a to maeke ni ke tuku hifo kaeke ko e tuku
hifo ia kua lauia ai e tau totogi oti ha lautolu ne moua ha ko e muituaaga ke he
fakatufono-tohi.
50 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

45 Fakaoti e Kotofaaga he tau Iki Fakafili

(1) Ko e Iki fakafili lahi mo e falu Iki fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi to nakai
maeke ke fakaoti mai he tau kotofaaga, ko e maeke ni ka moua mai e fakailoaaga
ke fakaoti mai he Kavana Lahi ha koe taliaaga he Fono Ikipule mo e omoiaga he
Palemia mo e fakamooliaga he Fono Ekepule Niue he fonoaga ne talia oti ki ai a
lautolu.
(2) Ko e taha ni e kakano ne kua maeke ai ke fakaoti ai e Iki Fakafili lahi
mo e ha Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga lahi ka hoko ke he tuaga kua nakai tuai maeke
he Iki Fakafili ke taute haana tau gahua kotofa, (tupu mai ha kua nakai malolo e
tino, po ke nakai malolo e manamanatuaga po ke ha mena tupu kia ia) po ke
mahani fakahanoa.

46 Tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga lahi

(1) Ko e Fono Ikipule ka fifili e tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga lahi ha
Niue, to gahua ai a lautolu ke he tau tau tuga ne tohia ai he ha lautolu a tau tohi
fakamooliaga ke he kotofaaga.
(2) To nakai fai tagata kua katoa e 64 e tau tau he moui, po ke ko e ekepule
he Fono Ekepule Niue ka fifili ke he kotofaaga nai po ke fakatumau ke nofo ai he
kotofaaga nai.
(3) Muitua ke he (2) he Matakupu nai, ko e kotofaaga Komisina Fakafili he
Fakafiliaga Lahi ka ko e tagata gahua to maeke ni e tagata ia ke fakatumau ke he
haana kotofaaga kaeke ke moua e fakamooliaga mai he Kau Pule Gahua, po ke
tagata gahua ke he ha gahua, ko e mena ia kaeke ko e Komisina Fakafili ko e
tagata gahua he kau gahua he tau kau gahua he Fakatufono to nakai maeke ia ia
he magaaho ke fakaaoga ai haana tau malolo kotofa faka-Komisina Fakafili ke
nofo ki lalo he puipuiaga he Kau Pule Gahua he Fakatufono Niue.
(4) To nakai fai fakafiliaga ka taute he Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga
Lahi he magaaho ka taute ai e ia haana tau malolo kotofa ke pehe kua nakai tonu
ha kua hoko ke he tau tau kua lata ke fakaoti ai mo e kotofaaga ke tuga ne tohia ai
he Matakupu nai, po ke ko e tau tau fafati he kotofaaga ke gahua ai kua molea
tuai.
(5) Ko e Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi maeke ia ia ke tohi ke he haana matalima tohi e haana tohi fakaoti gahua mo e taatu ke he Palemia.

47 Tau Komisina Fakafili nakai gahua mau

Maeke he Fono Ikipule he ha magaaho ke fifili ha tagata mo e nakai fai
kaupaaga e tau he moui ne kua kitia kua lata mo e kotofaaga ko e Komisina Fakafili
he Fakafiliaga lahi ke nakai molea e taha e tau tuga ne tohia he tohi fakamooliaga
gahua.

48 Malolo Pule he tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi

(1) Maeke he Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi ke moua e malolo pule
ke fakagahuahua haana tau gahua kotofa ko e Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi (ko
e malolo ia ko e malolo faka fakafiliaga po ke malolo ke he tau puhala gahua, ka e
nakai aofia ai e tau malolo pule ne foaki ke he Iki Fakafili Lahi) tuga ne tohia ai he
fakatufono hagaao ke he tau Komisina Fakafili oti po ke fakamahao ni ke he
tokotaha e Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi, mo e, ko e tau talahauaga ne
tohia ai he ha fakatufono tohi hagaao ke he Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi ne
maeke ke fakamooli aki kua hagaao foki e tau talahauaga ia ke he Komisina Fakafili
he Fakafiliaga Lahi, ka e fakakaupa mai ni ke he malolo pule ne foaki age ki a ia.
(2) Ko e fakaataaga moua mai he Komisina he Fale Hopo Lahi ke liu hafagi
mai he Iki Fakafili he Fale Hopo ia.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 51

49 Tau Palepale he tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi

(1) Ko e tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga lahi ke moua e tau totogi mo
e tau totogi lafi he tau magahala takitaha tuga ne tohia ai he fakatufono-tohi; ka e
kaeke ke fifili ha Komisina Fakafili ke he kotofaaga nai ke he tuaga nakai gahua
mau, to moua ni e ia e totogi mo e totogi lafi fakalata ke he tau magaaho ne gahua
ai a ia he haana a tau gahua kotofa tuga ne fifili a ia ki ai.
(2) Ko e tau totogi he tau Komisina Fakafili to moua mai he tokaaga tupe
he Fakatufono Niue.
(3) Ko e tau tau fafati ka gahua ai e Komisina Fakafili he haana kotofaaga
to maeke he haana totogi ke holo hake kaeke kua fai holo hake e tau totogi po ke
kakano ni kua lata ke holo hake ai, ka e nakai maeke ke fai magaaho ke holo hifo
ai he tau tau ne fafati ke gahua ai a ia ke he haana kotofaaga, a to maeke ni kaeke
ko e holo hifo e tau totogi oti po ke holo hifo taha he tau totogi ha lautolu oti ne
totogi ha ko e muituaaga ke he fakatufono-tohi.

50 Fakaoti e Kotofaaga Komisina Fakafili

(1) To nakai maeke e Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi ke fakaoti mai
he haana kotofaaga. Ka ko e Fono Ikipule ni ke maeke ke fakaoti e kotofaaga ia ha
ko e pulega ne tuku atu he Iki Fakafili Lahi ke he Fono Ikipule.
(2) Ko e kakano ni ke maeke ai e Komisina Fakafili ke fakaoti mai mo e
haana kotofaaga kaeke kua nakai maeke ia ia ke taute haana tau gahua kotofa
(tupu mai ha kua nakai malolo e tino po ke nakai mitaki e manamanatuaga po ke
ha mena ni ne tupu ki a ia) po ke mahani fakahanoa.

51 Tau Fakafili he Mafola

Tau Fakafili

(1) Ko e Fono Ikipule ke fifili e tau Fakafili he mafola ma Niue, to gahua ai a lautolu ia ke he tau tau tuga ne tohia ai he tau tohi fakamooliaga gahua.
(2) Ko e tokoua e tau Fakafili he mafola ma Niue ka gahua tokoua, mo e ha
ha ia laua e malolo ke fakagahua i Niue e ha gahua kotofa ne foaki atu he mata­
fakatufono ke he tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi, ti pihia ni mo e tau
fakafoouaga tuga ne tohia ai he Matakupu 48 he tohi Fakave nai, mo e fakahagaao
foki e tau fakafoouaga ia ke he tau kotofa he tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga
Lahi, mo e ke fakaaoga foki ke he ha tokoua e fakafili he mafola ma Niue; ka e
nakai hagaao e matakupu nai ke he ha Fakafili he mafola ma Niue ne gahua ekepule
he Fono Ekepule ha Niue po ko ia kua katoa e 68 e tau tau he moui.
(3) To nakai maeke e Fakafili he mafola ma Niue ke fakaoti mo e haana
kotofaaga a to moua e poakiaga ke fakaoti mai he Fono Ikipule ha ko e pulega mai
he Iki Fakafili Lahi.
(4) Ko e tau Fakafili he Mafola ke moua a tau palepale ha lautolu fakalata
ke he ha gahua kotofa ha lautolu ne gahua ki ai. Ko e tau palepale nai to muitua ni
ke he tau magahala takitaha tuga ne tohia ai he fakatufono-tohi.

Fakafiliaga Liu fakafili

52 Fakatu e Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili

(1) To ha ha i ai e Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili ha Niue mo e to fakamau ai ko e
Fakafiliaga kua mua he tokoluga moe malolo.
(2) Muitua ke he Matakupu 53 moe 54 ko e tau Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga
Liu Fakafili.
(a) Ko e Iki Fakafili lahi mo e falu Iki Fakafili he ha Fakafiliaga Lahi ko
lautolu ia ko e tau hukui kua fifili ke he Fakafiliaga nai ha ko ha
lautolu a tau mahani fakamooli mo e fakauka kua lata tonu ko e
kotofaaga; mo e
52 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(e ) Falu vahega tagata pehe nai kua lata tonu mo e kotofaaga ke tuga ne tohia ai he Fakatufono Tohi, to fifili ai a lautolu ia he Kavana Lahi ha ko e taliaaga he Fono Ikipule mo e omoiaga he Palemia.
(3) Ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi e takitaki he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili, ka e kaeke ke nakai ha ha i ai a ia ko e taha Iki fakafili ne kua leva haana gahua mo e motua ka hukui a ia.
(4) Ko e tau Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili to uta e tau tutuaga ha lautolu he tau kotofaaga ke he leva he gahua, kamata totou he aho ne kamata gahua ai he Fakafiliaga Lahi po ke kamata gahua he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili po ke ha fakafiliaga he ha motu i fafo i Niue.
(5) Ko e ha kotofaaga ne fifili i lalo hifo he palatafa (e) he (2) he matakupu nai ke fai magaaho ke tuku age ke fakamahani ai ke he fakafiliaga po ke fai magaaho ke tuku age ke fakanogonogo ke he taha fakafiliaga, ke tuga ne tohia ai he tohi fakamooliaga gahua.

53 Katoa he tau Iki fakafili

(1) Ko e toko 3 e Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili ke gahua fakalataha
he ha magaaho i Niue po ke i fafo i Niue, mo e, fakagahua ai e tau malolo pule ne
ha ha i ai he Fakafiliaga. Ka e maeke ni kaeke kua fita e fifiliaga fakaoti he
Fakafiliaga he moua he taha hukui ne kua ha ha i ai he magaaho tonu ia he
fakafiliaga, ka e kaeke ke nakai moua ha hukui to puhala atu ai e fifiliaga ia he
Fakafiliaga he Fakamau Kupu Lahi he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili.
(2) Ko e fifiliaga he Fakafiliaga Liu fakafili ke falanaki ni ke he manatu kua
tokologa ki ai e tau Iki Fakafili ne ha ha i ai he fakafiliaga.

54 Nakai maeke e Iki Fakafili ne taute e fifili he Fakafiliaga ke ha ha i ai a ia he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili ke liu fifili haana fifiliaga

Ko e Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili to nakai maeke ia ia ke ha ha i ai ke liu fakafili e ha fifiliaga ne taute e ia, po ke Fakafiliaga ne nofo ai a ia ko e taha Iki Fakafili.

55 Ko e fifiliaga he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili

(1) A to ke he ai ni ke tuga ne tohia ai he (2) he Matakupu nai, po ke tuga
ne tohia ai he fakatufono tohi, ko e fifiliaga he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili ko e fifiliaga
fakaoti ni a ia.
(2) To nakai fai talahauaga i loto he Matakupu nai ke taofi aki e tonuhia he
Patuiki ne ha ha ia ia ne lalago e ha tagata, kaeke kua nakai fiafia e ha tagata ke he
fifiliaga he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili kua lata ke taatu e nakai fiafia ia he tagata ke
he taha fakafiliaga ne kua kitia e ia kua lata ke uta ki ai.

55A Malolo Pule Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili

(1) Muitua ke he tau poakiaga he Tohi Fakave nei, ko e Fakafiliaga Liu
Fakafili ke ha ha i ai e malolo pule ke fanogonogo mo e fifili e ha ole ke liu fakafili
e fifiliaaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi.
(2) Muitua ke he tau poakiaga he Tohi Fakave nei mo e tau magaaho ke
taute ai e ole liu fakafili tuga ne tohia ai he Fakatufono Tohi, a to kehe ai ni kaeke
kua tohia ai he ha fakatufono tohi kua eke ni e fifiliaga ia he Fakafiliaga Lahi mo
e fifiliaga fakaoti, ti ko e ole ke liu fakafili kua nakai tuai talia he Fakafiliaga Liu
Fakafili ke liu fifili e fifiliaga, he Fakafiliaga Lahi –
(a) Ke lata mo e mooli, kaeke kua fakamooli he Fakafiliaga Lahi ko e
fakafiliaga ne taute kua mamafa lahi ni ke he fifiliaga he mata
fakatufono mo e to lauia ai foki e ha poakiaga he Tohi Fakave nei.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 53

(e) Ke lata mo e mooli, ko e ha fakahala ka fafati he Fakafiliaga Lahi ha ko e fakagahuahuaaga he tau malolo faka-fakafiliaga ke lata mo e holifono he tagata ne ole ke liu fakafili ha kua fafati ke fakahala mate po ke fakahala tuku ke he fale puipui a to hoko kehe aho ka mate ai, po ke ha vahega fakahala (kua nakai tohia he mata fakatufono) ka e tuga ka tohia ai he Fakatufono Tohi;
(i ) Ke lata mo e mooli kaeke kua nakai fai kakano aoga e matakupu ne fetoko ki ai e ole liu fakafili ke tuga ne tohia ai he Fakatufono Tohi;
(o) Kaeke ke toka ni ke he taliaaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi ke lata mo e falu
fakafiliaga, ti kaeke kua manatu e Fakafiliaga ia ko e matakupu ne
lago ki ai e ole ke liu fakafili ko e matakupu aoga mae tau tagata
oti, po ke aoga ni mo lautolu ne aofia ai, po ke ha kakano aoga ne
kua lata ai ke ta atu e matakupu ke fakafili he Fakafiliaga Liu
Fakafili.
(u) Ko e falu he tau mena tutupu kua fai fakamaamaaga ke lata mo e
fakatufono.
(3) Ke nakai fai mena ke taofi aki e (2) he Matakupu nai, a to kehe ai ni kaeke ke tohia ai he ha Fakatufono Tohi kua eke ni e fifiliaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi mo fifiliaga fakaoti, ka e maeke he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili ke lata mo e ha fekau ne manatu e Fakafiliaga ia kua lata ke talia pauaki ni ke tuku atu e ole ke liu fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi e fifiliaga ne taute he Fakafiliaga Lahi, ka muitua ke he tau tauteaga pehe nai kua lata ni ke moua e peehi ke puipui ke lata mo e tau tupe ke fakamole ke he kitiaaga kua manatu e Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili kua lata.
(4) Ko e taha vala he matafakatufono kua ai tohia kehe vagahau Niue.

55E Utaaga he tau Poakiaga Tohi he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili

Ko e fifiliaga he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili ke he ha Liu Fakafili mai he
Fakafiliaga Lahi to taatu ke he Fakamau Kupu Lahi he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili.
Ko e Poakiaga Tohi ia kua fakamau fakamailoga ai he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili. Ti
koe fifiliaga ia to tohi fakamau ai he Fakafiliaga Lahi po ke tohi fakamau ai mo e
taha fakaholoaga fakafiliaga foou, po ke toka ni ke he fifiliaga he Fakafiliaga Lahi
tuga ne fifili ki ai.

55I Omonuo he Mahani Fakamooli mo e Omonuo Faka-Fakafiliaga

(1) Ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi moe falu Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi mo e tau
Iki Fakafili oti he Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili, mo e tau Komisina Fakafili oti, mo e tau
Fakafili he Mafola ha Niue, ko e magaaho ka talia ai ke he kotofaaga to taute ai e
tau omonuo nai:
(a) Hanai e omonuo he mahani fakamooli –
Ko au ko kua omonuo nei au ke he Atua Malolo mua ue atu, to fekafekau au moe tua fakamooli, mo e toto mau e mahani tonu moe fakalilifu ki a ia e Patuiki (Hanai kua fakahigoa ai mo e haana Pule Malolo: Ko e Patuiki ko Elisapeta II) ko ia ko e Ulu he Fakatufono Niue, fakalataha mo e haana tau ohi mo e haana tau hukui ke lata mo e Tohi Fakave mo e Fakatufono he kautu. Ko e mena ia ki a lagomatai mai au ma Atua na e.
54 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Hanai e Omonuo Faka-Fakafiliaga
Ko au ko .kua omonuo nei au ke he Atua Malolo mua ue atu to fekafekau au mo e loto mo e mahani fakamooli ki a ia e Lilifu koe Patuiki (Hanai kua fakahigoa ai mo e haana Pule Malolo: Ko e Patuiki ko Elisapeta II) ko ia ko e Ulu he Fakatufono Niue fakalataha mo e haana tau ohi mo e haana tau hukui ke lata mo e Tohi Fakave mo e fakatufono he Kautu.
Ko e mena ia ki a lagomatai mai au ma Atua na e.
(2) Ko e tau omonuo ka taute ha ko e poakiaga he Matakupu nai to taute ai
ki mua ia lautolu nai –
(a) Ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi to taute ai ki mua he Kavana Lahi;
(e) Ke he falu Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi po ke ha Iki Fakafili he
Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili to taute ai ki mua he Kavana Lahi po ke ki
mua he Iki Fakafili Lahi;
(i) Ke he tau Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi, po ke tau Fakafili
he Mafola to taute ai ki mua he Iki Fakafili Lahi po ke ki mua he ha
Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi, po ke ki mua he Fakatonu Fono he
Fono Ekepule Niue.
(3) Ko e ha tagata ne kua fakatonu he Matakupu nai ke taute e omonuo ka
e fakatikai e ia mo e nakai talia e ia ke omonuo ka kua fita a ia he talia e kotofoaga,
ko e magaaho ia ni ke uta kehe ai e kotofoaaga mai ia ia, ka e nakai maeke ha
tagata ke fakaohooho ke omonuo lagaua ke he taha ni e kotofoaga: ka kua lata ke
nakai fai tauteaga ke he ha tagata pihia a to tuku ke he Fakafiliaga ke huhu ki ai
ko e ha ne nakai talia ai e ia ke taute e omonuo tuga ne tohia ai he Matakupu nai.
VALA IV
TAU TUPE MOUA HA NIUE

56 Levekiaga Faka-Fakatufono-tohi he tau tupe moua mo e tau tupe

fakamole

(1) To nakai maeke ke fai tukuhau ka fakatu ai, a to fai talahauaga i loto he
ha Fakatufono – tohi.
(2) Ko e tau tupe moua oti he Fakatufono Niue ki a tuku atu ki loto he
fakaputuaga tupe he kautu po ke ha fakamauaga tupe; ko e tupe oti ia po ke tau
fakamauaga tupe ia, to totogi ni a to kehe ka tohi ai i loto he fakatufono – tohi kua
fakagahua ai, to taute ni tuga ne fakatoka ai he Fakatufono – tohi.
(3) Ko e tau fakamoleaga oti he tau tupe he kautu to taute ke lata moe
poakiaga he fakatufono- tohi tigahau he fakagahua po ke poakiaga he ha
fakatufono – tohi ka taute pauaki.

57 Fakaputuaga Tupe he Fakatufono Niue

(1) To ha ha i ai e taha Fakaputuaga Tupe he Fakatufono Niue.
(2) Ko e tau tupe tukuhau oti mo e falu a tupe moua mo e tau tupe ne
kumi mo e moua he Fakatufono Niue ki a totogi atu ia ke he Fakaputuaga Tupe he
Fakatufono Niue, a to kehe ai ka fakaata ai faka-fakatufono-tohi ke totogi atu ke
he ha fakaputuaga tupe kehe he kautu.

58 Fakalatalataaga mo e Tufatufaaga he tau tupe ma e tau taha

(1) A to kehe ai ni kaeke kua ha ha he Matakupu 59 (4) (e) he Fakatufono –
tohi Fakave nei po ke kua fakaata mai ai i loto he taha la fono fakatufono-tohi po
ke he ha Fakatufono-tohi ka taute pauaki, ko e tau tupe fakamole oti mai he
Fakaputuaga Tupe he Fakatufono Niue to muitua ni tuga ke he tau fakatokaaga
ne talahau ai he Fakatufono – tohi Fakalatalata Tupe ma e tau ia.
(2) Ko e Fakatufono-tohi Fakalatalata Tupe to fakagahua ni ke lata mo e
taha e tau, mo e fakaoti ni haana a aoga he tau na.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 55

59 Ko e Fono He Tau Ikipule ke kitekite e fakamoleaga he tau tupe

(1) Ko e Fono Ikipule kua lago ki ai e poakiaga ke tuku ke he Fono Ekepule
e tau fakalatalataaga fakakaupa he tau tupe moua he kautu mo e tau tupe fakamole
he kautu he tau taha, a to pihia ai foki ke he falu a fekau hagaao ke he tupe. Ko e
Palemia po ke taha Ikipule ke tuku ki mua po ke fakailoa ke he Fono Ekepule e ha
Fakatufono – tohi Fakalatalata hagaao atu ia ke he ha fekau hagaao ke he tupe mo
e ha fakalatalata tupe kua amanaki ke fakamole ke lata moe tau taha.
(2) Ko e Fono He Tau Ikipule kua lago ki ai gahua mo e falanaki atu ki lalo
he Fono Ekepule hagaao ke he tau fakamauaga tonu he tau tupe fakamole ke
fakataitai atu ke he tau fatifatiaga ne taute ai he Fono Ekepule ke lata moe
Matakupu 58 he Fakatuono – tohi Fakave nei, po ke ha fakaataaga ke fakamooli e
tau tupe fakamole ke lata moe vala kupu (4) he Matakupu nei, mo e ko e tau
fakamauaga tupe ke ma e tau taha to tuku ai ke he Fono Ekepule.
(3) Ko e ha fakaataaga malolo pule foaki mai he Fono He Tau Ikipule, ko e
tokotaha po ke tokologa ha lautolu e ha malolo ke fakamooli e ha tupe fakamole
ke lata mo e ha fakatufono-tohi ne fakagahua ai he mogo ia mo e taute ai ke lata
mo e Fakatufono-tohi ka e nakai ha ha i ai ha kehekeheaga mai he gahua mo e
falanakiaga auloa he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke he gahuaaga tumau i lalo he
Matakupu nei.
(4) Ke lata moe tau fakakaupaaga tuku hifo he tau magahala takitaha tuga
ne toka ai he ha fakatufono-tohi po ke la fono-tohi ko e Fono he tau Ikipule ke
fakamooli e fakamoleaga he tau tupe kua manatu kua lata –
(a) Ke taute taha fakatokaaga amanaki he Fakatufono- tohi Fakalatalata
Tupe ma e ha tau taha; ka ko e tau tupe katoatoa ne tufa mo e totogi
ai i lalo he palatafa nei he fakatatai atu ai ke he ha vahega gahua he
tau taha, ki a nakai molea e tau fatifati tupe ne nakai fakamole he
Fakatufono-tohi Fakalatalata tupe he tau kua mole, lafi ki ai e taha
e mena ke fa-aki he vahega gahua ia, ti ko e tau tupe ki a lafi
fakalataha e totouaga ke he fakalatalataaga ma e tau ia.
(e) Ko e magahala he vahloto to fakamooli e Fakatufono-tohi
Fakalatalata Tupe moe fakaotiaga he tau taha kua maeke e tau tupe
ia ke fakamole ke molea, mo e nakai fai fakamooli ke moua mai he
Fono Ekepule, ka koe tau tupe oti ne foaki mo e totogi ai he palatafa
nei he ha tau taha ki a nakai molea e taha mo e hafa e pasene he tau
tupe katoa oti ne fatifati ai i loto he Fakatufono-tohi Fakalatalata
Tupe he tau ia.
(5) Ko e ha tupe fakamole ne fakagahua ki lalo he fakaataaga he Matakupu
(4) (e) he Matakupu nei, to tohia ai ko e tau tupe fakamole mo e nakai fakaata ti
totou ko e fakamoleaga mai he taha fatifatiaga kua lata tonu ai.
(6) Ko e fakailoaaga he tupe fakamole ne nakai fai fakaataaga ma e tau ia to
lalafi atu ia ke he fakailoaaga tupe ma e tau ia mo e tuku atu ai ke he Fono Ekepule.

60 Siviaga he tau Tupe

(1) Ko e Faahi Gahua Sivi Tupe ha Niu Silani ke eke mo Sivi Tupe he
Fakaputuaga Tupe he Fakatufono Niue mo e tau fakaputuaga tupe oti he tau Faahi
Gahua Fakatufono mo e tau Ofisa he fakatufono pule fakatonu mo e falu matakau
fakatu faka fakatufono kua lauia ai i lalo he ha fakatufono-tohi.
(2) To lagataha he tau e taute e fakailoaaga mo e fakailoa atu he Faahi
Gahua Sivi Tupe ke he Fakatonu Fono he Fono Ekepule Niue ke tuku ke he Fono
Ekepule e fakailoaaga ne toka ai ha talahauaga tuga ne poaki ai he ha fakatufono­
tohi lafi ki ai foki mo e falu a fakailoaaga hagaao ia ke he tau Fakaputuaga Tupe
he Fakatufono po ke falu he tau vahega tupe kua tohia ai i lalo he Fakatufono –
tohi Fakave nei po ke i lalo he ha fakatufono –tohi kua lata ke sivi ai he Faahi
Gahua Sivi Tupe kaeke kua kitia kua lata ke taute pihia.
56 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
VALA V
FAAHI GAHUA MALOLO TINO, GAHUA FAKAAKO MO E FAAHI FIAFIA MOUI TINO

61 Faahi Gahua Malolo Tino, Faahi Gahua Fakaako mo e Faahi Fakafiafia

he Moui Tino

(1) To ha ha he Fono he Tau Ikipule e lauiaaga malolo ke fakatu mo e
fakatumau i Niue e levekiaga he tau fale gagao mo e falu matakau mo e foaki atu
e falu e fekafekeauaga ke lata ma e tau malolo tino he tau tagata.
(2) Ha ha foki he Fono He Tau Ikipule e lauiaaga malolo ke fakatu i Niue
mo e fakatumau i Niue e levekiaga he tau aoga mo e taute ai e falu a fakamauaga
kua lata ia ma e foakiaga he tau fakaakoaga mitaki ma e tau tagata Niue.
(3) Ha ha he Fono He Tau Ikipule e lauiaaga malolo ke fakatu mo e
fakatumau i Niue falu he tau matakau mo e falu gahua ke taute e falu a mena kua
lata ma e tau nonofoaga he tau tagata i Niue ke fakatumau e leveki he tau puhala
moua mena, fiafia mo e fakatumauaga he tau mahani motu.
(4) Nakai fai mena he Matakupu nai kua maeke ke fakakaupa aki e tau
malolo ha he Fono he Tau Ikipule ne toka he Matakupu 2 he Fakatufono-tohi-
Fakave nei, ke fakagahua ma e higoa haana he Patuiki Fifine, kua pule Fakatonu
i Niue.
VALA VI
KO E KAU GAHUA FAKATUFONO NIUE

62 Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue

(1) To ha ha i ai e Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue kua ha ha i ai e tau tagata
gahua ke maeke ke lagomatai e Fono He Tau Ikipule ke gahua e tau gahua kotofa
i Niue mo e taute ai e falu a gahua mo e falu a malolo pule fakatonu, ne moua ha
ko e fakatokaaga he ha fakatufono-tohi.
(2) A to kehe ni kaeke ke toka i loto he vala kupu (4) he Matakupu nei, to
nakai maeke ha tagata ke gahua ma e Fakatufono Niue a to pehe ko ia ko e tagata
gahua he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue.
(3) A to kehe ai ni kaeke kua fai talahauaga kehe he taha Fakatufono-tohi
ko e gahua ma e taha matakau, po ke ha matakau fakatu faka-fakatufono, po ke
ha matakau kua fakatu ai i lalo he taha fakatufono-tohi a Niue, ke lata mo e
Matakupu nei, kua talahau pehe kua gahua he gahua he Fakatufono Niue.
(4) Nakai hagaao e vala kupu (2) he Matakupu nei ke lauia ai ha gahua
kua totogi faka-konotuleke mai he tau tupe totogi palepale, po ke ha gahua taute
noa, po ke ha gahua he –
(a) Fakafili po ke Komisina Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Lahi, po ke ha
Lagomatai Fakafili ma Niue, po ke ha tagata gahua faka fakafiliaga
ne kotofa po ke ke lata mo e taha la fono – tohi ne fakagahua po ke
taha Fakatufono tohi; po ke
(b) Ha Ikipule po ke taha Ekepule, po ke Fakatonu Fono he Fono
Ekepule; po ke
(c) Taha tagata he Kau Pule Gahua Ha Niue.

63 Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono

(1) To ha ha i ai taha ke kotofa mai he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue ke
fakahigoa ai ko e Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono, ko ia ko e ulu gahua mau he Kau
Gahua Fakatufono Niue mo e ko e takitaki lahi he tau gahua taute he Fakatufono
Niue.
(2) Ke lalafi atu ke he falu he haana a tau gahua mo e tau malolo kotofa ne talahau mai he ha fakatufono – tohi, ko e Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono to gahua a ia mo e falanaki atu ke he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke lata ma e tau fakatonutonuaga he

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 57

tau gahua he tau faahi gahua oti mo e tau ofisa he Fakatufono pule fakatonu. Ko e tau ulu he tau Faahi Gahua po ke ofisa kua lago ki ai e fakaholoaga mitaki mo e tonu he tau gahua he Faahi Gahua ia po ke ofisa ia, mo e falanakai atu ki lalo he Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono, a to pihia atu foki e falanakiaga ia ki lalo he Ikipule he Faahi Gahua ia, po ke ofisa, po ke ha fekau i lalo he haana levekiaga.
(3) Nakai fai talahauaga he Matakupu 69 (2) he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave
nei ke tauhele atu ke he tonuhia he Kau Pule Gahua Niue, ke kumi atu mo e
fakatonu atu ke he Palemia ke maeke ke moua mai e taliaaga he Fono He Tau
Ikipule, to maeke ke kotofa e ha tagata ke eke mo Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono.
(4) Nakai fai fakatufono-tohi po ke la fono-tohi ke maeke ai e ha ole liu
fifili he ha tagata gahua he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue ke tuku hagaao atu ia ke
he ha fakaholo ki luga po ke kotofaaga he ha tagata kua fifili ke he kotofaaga he
Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono.

64 Kau Pule Gahua he Fakatufono Niue

(1) To ha ha i ai e Matakau Kau Pule Gahua ma Niue to fakahigoa e Matakau
ia koe Kau Pule Gahua he Fakatufono Niue.
(2) To toko 3 a lautolu ka fifili he Fono Ikipule ke eke mo tau hukui.
(3) Ko e takitaki ha lautolu to fifili foki he Fono Ikipule mai ia lautolu
tokotolu.
(4) Ko e Takitaki mo e tau hukui to gahua ai a lautolu ke he 3 e tau, ka e
maeke foki a lautolu mai he tau magahala takitaha ke liu fifili.
(5) Ko e tau hukui oti to moua e tau totogi, tau tupe lafi mo e tau tupe
lagomatai ka fifili he Fono Ikipule he tau magahala takitaha.
(6) Maeke ke hukui ke fakaoti haana kotofaaga he ha magaaho ke he tohi
taatu ke he Palemia, po ke uta kehe he Fono Ikipule a ia mai he kotofoaga, kakano
ha kua nakai tuai maeke ia ia ke taute haana tau gahua kotofa (ha kua nakai malolo
e tino po ke manamanatuaga po ke ha kakano foki) po ke mahani fakahanoa.

65 Tau Hukui lagomatai he Kau Pule Gahua

(1) Ko e magaaho ka iloa ai kua nakai tuai maeke he ha hukui he Kau Pule
Gahua ke taute haana gahua ha kua gagao, po ke fano kehe mo e motu po ke ha
mena tupu, ko e Fono Ikipule ka fifili taha ke lagomatai e gahua he hukui ia he tau
magaaho ne nakai maeke ai ia ia ke taute haana gahua.
(2) Ti ko e ha tagata ka fifili ke lagomatai e gahua he hukui he Kau Pule
Gahua tuga ne tohia ai he Matakupu nai, to moua e ia e tonuhia ke he tau mena
oti he hukui he Kau Pule Gahua, mo e ko e kotofaaga he ha tagata pehe nai, mo e
ko e ha gahua ka taute e ia ko e hukui he Kau Pule Gahua to nakai maeke he ha
fonoaga ke huhu haana kotofoaaga ha kua nakai iloa po ke kua fakaoti.

66 Puhala gahua he Kau

(1) Ka tokoua e tagata he Kau Pule Gahua Niue kua maeke tuai ke fakahoko
e fono, he ha magaaho ka fono ai.
(2) To maeke e Kau ke uiina taha kua kitia kua lata ke lagomatai ke
lagomatai atu ke he tau fakatutalaaga he fono.
(3) Ki a tokoua e tagata he Kau ka tatai e tau manatu pulega he Kau to
maeke he ha fifiliaga ke fai kakano po ke aoga.
(4) Ko e ha mena ka pulega ki ai e Kau he ha fonoaga, po ke ha fifiliaga
foki kua taute ke he tau kupu fakamau he Kau ti fakamooli matalima tohi ai e
lautolu oti i loto he Kau, to pehe ai kua aoga e tau tauteaga ia.
(5) Ke lafi atu ke he tau fakatokaaga he Fakatufono–tohi Fakave nei to
fakatoka ni he Kau haana e tau puhala taute gahua.
58 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

67 Ko e Foakiaga he tau Malolo Kotofa

(1) Mo e nakai tauhele atu ke he poakiaga ma e fakaholoaga tumau he
gahua he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue, ko e Kau Pule Gahua Niue, mai he taha
magahala ke he taha magahala, kua maeke ke foaki e falu he haana a tau malolo
kotofa ke lata ma e Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue (lafi atu ki ai e malolo kotofa nei)
ke he taha he Kau po ke taha tagata kehe po ke ke he Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono.
(2) Ke lata mo e ha fakatonuaga ne tuku mai he Kau ko e ha tagata kua
foaki ki ai e malolo kotofa to gahua ni a ia ki ai, ke pehe kua taute e haana a gahua
ke tuga ni ko e tohia ai pauaki he ha fakatufono – tohi po ke ha la fono-tohi pauaki
ki a ia, ka e nakai ko e malolo kotofa ne foaki ki a ia.
(3) Ko e ha tagata ne kua talahau kua gahua a ia ke lata mo e malolo kotofa
ne foaki age ki a ia i lalo he Matakupu nei, to pehe ai kua gahua ni a ia ke tuga mo
e talahauaga ia, mo e nakai fai talahauaga kua kehe a to kehe ni ka fai fakakiteaga
fakamooli ne talahau ai ko e kehe.
(4) Ko e foakiaga he ha malolo kotofa i lalo he vala kupu nei to taute ni e
ia, po ko lautolu, po ke ha vahega kua fakakite tonu ke taute e gahua ia, po ke
pihia foki kia taha kua fakakite tonu e kotofoaaga.
(5) Ko e foakiaga he ha malolo kotofa i lalo he vala kupu nei to nakai maeke
ke tauhele atu ke he tonuhia ha i ai he taha, po ke Kau, ne foaki e malolo kotofa ia,
ke taute e gahua kua tonuhia ki ai.

Gahuahuaaga mo e Levekiaga he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue

68 Tau Gahua mo e tau Malolo Kotofa he Kau

(1) Ko e Kau Pule Gahua Niue to eke ia mo kau ke fakagahua e tau tagata
ma e Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue, ti, fakalataha mo e muitua ke he Fakatufono –
tohi Fakave nei, to ha ha i ai e malolo katoa ke leveki mo e puipui e haana a
gahuahuaaga, mo e ha ha i ai foki e levekiaga mo e holoaga mitaki he tau gahua
he tau faahi gahua oti mo e tau ofisa he fakatufono pule fakatonu.
(2) Ke lafi atu ke he tau tauteaga Fakave he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei po
ke ha la fono-tohi, to maeke he Kau Pule ke fakakite e tau fakatokatokaaga ke lata
ma e fakagahuahuaaga he tau tagata he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue, mo e to
fakafano e tau fakatonutonuaga po ke fakagahua e tau malolo kotofa ke lata ia ke
taute aki e tau gahua tuga ne toka ai he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei po ke tuga ne
toka ai i loto he ha fakatufono-tohi.
(3) Ha koe tauteaga he tau gahua mo e fakaaogaaga he tau malolo kotofa
kua toka ai hagaao ia ke he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue, ko e Kau Pule Gahua
kua ataina ke taute e tau kumikumiaga he ha vahega he tau vahega kumikumi
fekau kaeke kua manatu kua lata ke eke pihia,mo e ke lata mo e ha kumikumiaga
pihia, ko e tonuhia mo e malolo kua talahau nai kua ha ha he Kau Pule ia, ke ui
poaki kia lautolu kua lata ke fai fakakiteaga talahau fakamooli mo e ke moua e
tau talahauaga fakamooli tuga ne toka ai ke he ha Kau Kumikumi ha ko e ha
fakatufono – tohi.
(4) A to kehe ni kaeke ko e muitua ke he Matakupu 69 (2) he Fakatufono
Fakave nei, to gahua e Kau mo e falanaki atu ke he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke lata ia
mo e tauteaga ke he haana tau gahua mo e fakaaogaaga he tau malolo kotofa ha i
ai, ti ko e Kau kua poaki ai nai ke fakailoa atu po ke fakatonu atu ke he Fono He
Tau Ikipule, kaeke kua lata, e ha mena kua lauia ai e tau Kau Gahua Fakatufono
Niue.
(5) Ko e Kau ka mole e aho 31 ia Mati he tau tau oti, kua poaki nei ki ai ke tuku atu fakamafiti ke he Fono He Tau Ikipule e fakailoaaga hagaao ke he holo mitaki he gahua he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue ke lata mo e tau taha ne fakaoti ai he aho ia. Ko e lagaki he fakailoaaga ia ki a tuku atu foki ke he Fono Ekepule Niue.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 59

69 Tau Kotofaaga ke he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue

(1) Ko e tau tagata gahua oti he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue to kotofa ni
he Kau Pule Gahua Niue, ka e muitua atu ke he Fakatufono – tohi Fakave nei moe
ha la fono –tohi po ke fakatufono – tohi, to gahua ni a lautolu ke he tau fakatonuaga
mo e tau fakatokatokaaga kua taute he Kau.
(2) Ko e tau mena oti po ke tau talahauaga hagaao ke he tau tagata gahua
takitaha (hagaao ke he kotofaaga, holo ki luga e kotofa, tuku hifo e kotofa, hiki e
kotofa, hatakiaga, fakaoti kotofa, po ke taha mena kehe) to nakai falanaki e Kau
ke he ha fakatonu pule mai he Fono He Tau Ikipule, ka e to gahua ni e Kau ke
taute e tau mena ia kua fakamau ki ai mo e tu ke he tuaga tu-tokotaha.
(3) Ko e ha fakatuaga mo e liu fakafoouaga he tau fakatokatokaaga gahua
po ke fanoaga he tau palepale he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue, ko e tau mena fifili
ki ai, ki a lafi ki ai e tau mena nei –
(a) Ke lata mo e tonuhia he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue ke fakatumau
e gahuaaga mitaki ke he tau gahua, kua lata ke kitia ko e holo tatai
e puke tagata gahua mo e tau gahua ke taute, ti mua atu e aoga ke
kitekite makutu atu ke kitia ko e tau vahega gahua kehekehe kua
loga ke lata mo e tau Niue iloilo mo e makaka he gahua.
(e ) Ko e manako ke fakaata e tau pu gahua ke maeke ke fakagahua aki
e tau tagata Niue ha ko lautolu ko e tau tagata Niue, ti kua lata ke
muitua e tauteaga ia mo e onoono fakatatai atu fakamakutu ke he
loga he tau gahua i Niu Silani pihia mo e tau fafatiaga totogi.
(i) Ko e manako ke gahua mo e falanaki fakatatai atu ke he tau
hagaaoaga he fakatupuaga ki mua he moui mitaki mo e monuina
he motu ne fakatoka he Fakatufono mo e manatu ko e tau
fakatokatokaaga gahua he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue ko e mena
ke mitaki ai ni a Niue.
(4) Ko e tau totogi mo e tau tupe lafi ki luga he tau tagata gahua he Kau
Gahua Fakatufono Niue to totogi mai ni he Fakaputuaga Tupe he Fakatufono
Niue, ko e tau tupe ne fakaata mai he Fono Ekepule ke fakamole.

70 Ko e Kau Pule ke taute fakailoaaga mo e tau pulega ke he Fono Ekepule

(1) Ke lata mo e Matakupu 25 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, ko e poaki
nei ke he Kau Pule Gahua Niue, he tau magahala takitaha, ka kitia kua lata, ke
tuku atu e fakailoaaga mo e ha pulega ke he Fono Ekepule, hagaao ia ke he tuaga
he tau totogi mo e falu a tupe moua he Palemia, tau Ikipule ne toe mo e tau Ekepule
ne nakai ko e tau Ikipule mo e Fakatonu Fono, ti ko e Kau Pule Gahua ka taute e
Fakailoaaga mo e tau pulega kaeke kua ha ha i ai e ha hikihikiaga he tuaga he tau
totogi he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue.
(2 Ko e Kau Pule Gahua kua poaki nai ki ai ke tuku atu ke he Fakatonu
Fono e ha fakailoaaga po ke ha pulega tuga ne toka ai he vala kupu (1) he Matakupu
nei.
(3) Ka e kaeke, ke lata mo e Matakupu 32 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, kua lata e Kau Pule Gahua Niue ke tuku e ha fakailoaaga hagaao ke he tonuhia faka-fakatufono, po ke faka fakatufono-tohi Fakave, po ke ha fakatokaaga faka fakatufono ne talahau mai he Fakatufono Fakalatalata po ke fakahuiaga fakalataha he vahloto he magaaho kua fafati nei ke kaupa mai he taha e mahina mai he aho ne tuku ai e ole ke moua mai e fakailoaaga ke he Fakatonu Fono, po ke ka manako ki ai, ke moua mai e falu a fakailoaaga lafi a to fakailoa ke he Fakatonu Fono e fakailoaaga fakahiku.
60 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
VALA VII
TAU FATOKATOKAAGA MA E MATUTAKIAGA HE FAKATUFONO

71 Fakatumau e tau fakatufono-tohi tuai ke lata mo e Fakatufono-tohi Fakave

Mo e muitua ai ke he Fakatufono–tohi Fakave nei –
(a) Ko e tau fakatufono –tohi he mogonei to fakatumau ni ke fakaaoga
ka hoko po ke molea e Aho Fakakatoatoaaga he Pule Fakamotu a
to utakehe po ke fakahui ai.
(b) Ko e tau tonuhia, tau mena mo e tau fekau lata ke taute po ke tau
kaitalofa, i lalo he tau fakatufono-tohi he mogonei to tumau ni ka
hoko po ke molea e Aho Fakakatoatoaaga he Pule Fakamotu, to
tumau ni ke mailoga mo e fakagahua ni pihia.

72 – 80 Koe falu vala he tohi fakave nei kua nakai tuai fakaaoga

81 Fakamailoga a Niue

A to talia la he Fono He Tau Ikipule ke talaga po ke taute e taha Fakamailoga
foou, ko e Fakamailoga a Niue ne talahau mai he Matakupu 15 he Fakatufono –
tohi Fakave nei, ko e talaga ia kua talia ki ai e Fono Komiti Fakatufono ke eke mo
fakamailoga a Niue ne fakatu ai he Matakupu 7 he Matapatu Fakatufono–tohi
Niue 1966 (mo e ha ne toka ai he Matakupu 3 he Matapatu Fakatufono–tohi Fakahui
ha Niue 1971).

82 Fakamaamaaga

VALA VIII FAKAMAAMAAGA
(1) He Fakatufono–tohi Fakave nei, a to kehe ai ni ka talahau pauaki ko e kehe, ko e –
“Aho Fakakatoatoaaga he Pule Fakamotu”, kakano ko e aho ne kamata fakagahua ai e Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei.
“Fakafili”, ke lata mo e Fakafiliaga Lahi, kakano ko e ha Fakafili he
Fakafiliaga Lahi ia, lafi ki ai e Iki Fakafili Lahi.
“Fakafiliaga Lahi”, kakano ko e Fakafiliaga Lahi a Niue ne fakatu ai i lalo
hifo he Matakupu 37 he Tohi Fakave nei.
“Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili”, kakano ko e Fakafiliaga Liu Fakafili ha Niue ne
fakatu ai i lalo hifo he Matakupu 52 he Tohi Fakave nei.
“Fakamau Kupu he Fono Ekepule”, kakano ko e Fakamau Kupu he Fono
Ekepule Niue ne kotofa ai i lalo he Matakupu 27 he Fakatufono-tohi
Fakave nei.
“Fakamau Kupu he Fono He Tau Ikipule”, kakano ko e Fakamau Kupu he
Fono He Tau Ikipule ha Niue ne kotofa ai i lalo he Matakupu 14 he
Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei.
“Fakatufono-tohi”, kakano ko e ha Fakatufono – tohi he Fono Ekepule
Fakave ha Niue tuga ne toka ai he Matakupu 34 he Fakatufono-tohi
Fakave nei.
“Fakatufono-tohi Fakave”, kakano ko e Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, lafi ki
ai e Matapatu Fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule (Palemene) Niu Silani
ne fakahigoa ko e Matapatu Fakatufono-tohi Fakave ha Niue 1974; lafi
ki ai e ha fakahuiaga fakafakatufono-tohi fakave, tuga ne fakaaoga ai
he Matakupu 35 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei, he magaaho ka
fakamooli e ha fakahuiaga ia mo e fakagahua ai.

Ko e Fakatufono-Tohi Fakave A Niue 61

“Fakatufono-tohi”, po ke “La Fakatufono-tohi” –
(a) Kakano ko e ha Fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule mo e ha la
fakatufono-tohi; ha poakiaga, la fono po ke ha mena ni kua taute ai
i lalo he ha Fakatufono-tohi po ke ha la fakatufono-tohi.
(e) Ko e ha Matapatu Fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule (Palemene)
Niu Silani kua hokotia foki e fakagahua ki Niue ke eke mo taha
vala he tau fakatufono-tohi a Niue po ke ha Poakiaga mai he
Kanesila, Fakapuloaaga, poakiaga, la fakatufono-tohi, tohi kotofa
faka-Ikipule, la fono po ke ha mena pihia tuga ne taute ha koe
muitua ke he ha Fakatufono-tohi tuga ne talahau he palatafa nai,
kaeke ko e tau mena oti ia kua pehe kua fakagahua ko e taha vala
he tau Fakatufono-tohi a Niue.
“Fono He Tau Ikipule”, ko e kakano ko e Fono He Tau Ikipule a Niue ne
fakatu he Matakupu 2 he Fakatufono tohi Fakave nei.
“Iki Fakafili Lahi” ko e kakano ko e Iki Fakafili Lahi he Fakafiliaga Tokoluga
ha Niue kua kotofa ai i lalo hifo he matakupu 42 he Tohi Fakave mo e
putoia ai falu he tau Iki Fakafili he Fakafiliaga Tokoluga kua fakamooli
ai he matakupu 40 he Tohi Fakave ke he haana kotofaaga gahua poke
taute ai falu he tau gahua he Iki Fakafili Lahi.
“Tau Fakatufono Mogonei”, kakano ko e tau Fakatufono–tohi oti ne
fakagahua ai i Niue to hoko e Aho Fakakatoatoaaga he Pule Fakamotu;
lafi ki ai e ha fakatufono – tohi ne fakamooli po ke eke mo e fakagahua
ai fakamua po ke mole e Aho Fakakatoatoaaga he Pule Fakamotu.
“Fakatufono-tohi, kakano ko e ha fakatufono-tohi ni ne fakagahua ai i Niue
lafi ki ai e Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei mo e ha la fakatufono-tohi.
“Ekepule he Fono Ekepule”, po ke “Ekepule”, kua fakaaoga ia ke lata mo e
Fono Ekepule Niue, kakano ko e ha tagata kua fifili ke eke mo Ekepule
he Fono Ekepule ke lata moe Matakupu 16 he Fakatufono – tohi Fakave
nei; ka e nakai koe Fakatufono Fono; mo e ka pehe kua tuku e Fono
Ekepule to fakahoko atu ia ke lata mo e kakano he vala kupu (4) he
Matakupu ia.
“Ikipule”, koe kakano ko e ha Ikipule he Fono He Tau Ikipule; lafi ki ai e
Palemia ; lafi ki ai ha Ekepule he Fono Ekepule ne kotofa mo Ikipule
Hukui leveki ke lata mo e Matakupu 8 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei.
“Fono Ekepule Niue” po ke “Fono”, ko e Fono Ekepule a Niue ne fakatu ai
he Matakupu 16 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei.
“Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue”, ko e Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue ne fakatu
ai i lalo he Matakupu 62 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakavei nei.
“Kau Pule Gahua Fakatufono Niue” po ke “Kau Pule Gahua”, kakano ko e
Kau Pule Gahua Fakatufono Niue ne fakatu he Matakupu 64 he
Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei.
“La fakatufono-tohi”, kakano ko e ha Fakatufono-tohi he Fono Ekepule he
Motu ko Niue po ke Fono Tufono he Motu ko Niue.
“Palemia”, ko e kakano ko e Ekepule he Fono Ekepule ne fifili ke eke mo
Palemia ke lata mo e Matakupu 4 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei he
mole atu e fifiliaga haana ke eke mo Ikipule ke lata mo e Matakupu 5
he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei; lafi ki ai e Ikipule ne fifili ke taute e tau
gahua he Palemia ke lata mo e vala kupu (1) po ke vala kupu (2) he
Matakupu 9 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei.
“Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono”, kakano ko e Tohi Kupu he Fakatufono ne
kotofa he Matakupu 63 he Fakatufono-tohi Fakave nei.
62 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“Fakatonu Fono”, kakano ko e Fakatonu Fono he Fono Ekepule Niue ne fifili ke lata mo e Matakupu 20 he Fakatufono–tohi Fakave nei; lafi ki ai e ha Ekepule he Fono Ekepule Niue kua fifili ke taute e gahua he Fakatonu Fono ke lata mo e Matakupu ia.
(2) I loto he Fakatufono–tohi Fakave nei ko e ha tagata kua lata ke omonuo, to maeke ke talia a ia, ka manako ki ai, ke taute fakamooliaga ka e nakai ko e omonuo ne, taute ai he Fakatufono–tohi Fakave nei, ti hiki ni e tau kupu fakatoka he omonuoaga ke lata ni mo e mena ka fakamooli ki ai.
(3) I loto he Fakatufono–tohi Fakave nei ko e ha tagata kua ha ha i ai e
kotofa i loto he Kau Gahua Fakatufono Niue, ko e ha talahauaga ki a ia ne toka ai
e kotofaaga ia, ki a taute ni e ia e kotofaaga ia lafi ki ai e malolo kotofa ke taute e
tau gahua oti he kotofaaga ia.
63

NIUE CONSTITUTION ACT 1974

1974/42(NZ) – 19 October 1974

1

Short title

7

Economic and administrative assistance

2

Application to Niue

8

Co-operation between New Zealand and

3

Niue to be self-governing

Niue

4

Constitution of Niue

9

New Zealand Representative

5

British nationality and New Zealand

citizenship

SCHEDULES

6

External affairs and defence

An Act to make provision for self-government by the people of Niue, and to provide a constitution for Niue

1 Short title

This Act is the Niue Constitution Act 1974.

2 Application to Niue

This Act shall extend to Niue as part of the law of Niue.

3 Niue to be self-governing

Niue shall be self-governing.

4 Constitution of Niue

(1) The Constitution set out in its Niuean language version in the First
Schedule to this Act and in its English language version in the Second Schedule
shall be the Constitution of Niue (in this Act called the Constitution), and shall be
the supreme law of Niue.
(2) Where the Constitution provides that any New Zealand Court or
Department of Government or statutory authority shall perform any function or
exercise any power in relation to Niue, that Court, or, as the case may be, the
officers of that Department or the members and staff of that authority are by this
Act authorised and required to perform that function or exercise that power in
accordance with the Constitution.

5 British nationality and New Zealand citizenship

Nothing in this Act or in the Constitution shall affect the status of any person
as a British subject or New Zealand citizen by virtue of the British Nationality and
New Zealand Citizenship Act 1948.
64 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

6 External affairs and defence

Nothing in this Act or in the Constitution shall affect the responsibilities of
Her Majesty the Queen in right of New Zealand for the external affairs and defence
of Niue.

7 Economic and administrative assistance

It shall be a continuing responsibility of the Government of New Zealand
to provide necessary economic and administrative assistance to Niue.

8 Co-operation between New Zealand and Niue

Effect shall be given to the provisions of section 6 and 7 of this Act, and to
any other aspect of the relationship between New Zealand and Niue which may
from time to time call for positive co-operation between New Zealand and Niue,
after consultation between the Prime Minister of New Zealand and the Premier of
Niue, and in accordance with the policies of their respective Governments; and, if
it appears desirable that any provision be made in the law of Niue to carry out
these policies, that provision may be made in the manner prescribed in the
Constitution, but not otherwise.

9 New Zealand Representative

(1) There shall be appointed under the State Services Act 1962 a New
Zealand Representative in Niue.
(2) The New Zealand Representative shall be stationed in Niue, and shall
be the representative of the Government of New Zealand in Niue.

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE 1

[The Constitution of Niue (Niuean Language Version) – this is reproduced earlier

in this volume.]

–––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 2

[The Constitution of Niue (English Language Version) – this is reproduced earlier

in this volume.]

65

LETTERS PATENT CONSTITUTING THE

OFFICE OF GOVERNOR-GENERAL OF NEW ZEALAND

1983/225

1

Office

of

Governor-General

and

11

Exercise of Prerogative of Mercy

Commander-in-Chief constituted

12

Administrator of the Government

2

Appointment of Governor-General and

13

Oaths to be taken by Administrator of the

Commander-in-Chief

Government

3

Governor-General’s powers and authorities

14

Powers and authorities of Governor­

4

Manner in which Governor-General’s

General not abridged

powers and authorities are to be executed

15

[Revoked]

5

Publication

of

Governor-General’s

16

Ministers to keep Governor-General

Commission

informed

6

Oaths to be taken by Governor-General

17

Ministers and others to obey, aid, and assist

7

Constitution of Executive Council

Governor-General

8

Membership of Executive Council

18

Power reserved to Her Majesty to revoke,

9

Quorum of Executive Council

alter, or amend the present Letters Patent

10

Appointment of Members of Executive

19

Present Letters Patent to have effect as law

Council, etc

ELIZABETH R
ELIZABETH THE SECOND, by the Grace of God Queen of New Zealand and Her Other Realms and Territories, Head of the Commonwealth, Defender of the Faith:
To all to whom these presents shall come, Greeting:

Recites Letters Patent of 11 May 1917

WHEREAS by certain Letters Patent under the Great Seal of the United
Kingdom bearing date at Westminster the 11th day of May 1917, His late Majesty
King George the Fifth constituted, ordered and declared that there should be a
Governor-General and Commander-in-Chief in and over the Dominion of New
Zealand:

Recites Letters Patent of 18 December 1918

AND WHEREAS by certain Letters Patent under the Great Seal of the United
Kingdom bearing date at Westminster the 18th day of December 1918, His late
Majesty King George the Fifth made other provision for the publication and the
coming into operation of the said Letters Patent bearing date the 11th day of May
1917, in lieu of the provision made in the Fifteenth Clause thereof:

Recites Royal Instructions of 11 May 1917

AND WHEREAS at the Court at St. James’s on the 11th day of May 1917,
His late Majesty King George the Fifth caused certain instructions under the Royal
Sign Manual and Signet to be given to the Governor-General and Commander-in-
Chief:
66 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Recites Dormant Commission of 23 July 1917

AND WHEREAS at the Court at St. James’s on the 23rd day of July 1917,
His late Majesty King George the Fifth caused a Dormant Commission to be passed
under the Royal Sign Manual and Signet, appointing the Chief Justice or the Senior
Judge for the time being of the Supreme Court of New Zealand, to administer the
Government of New Zealand, in the event of the death, incapacity, or absence of
the Governor-General and Commander-in-Chief and of the Lieutenant-Governor
(if any):

Recites Approval by Executive Council of draft of new Letters Patent

AND WHEREAS, by Order in Council bearing date at Wellington the 26th
day of September 1983, Our Governor-General and Commander-in-Chief of New
Zealand, acting by and with the advice and consent of the Executive Council of
New Zealand, has requested the issue of new Letters Patent revoking and
determining the sad Letters Patent bearing date the 11th day of May 1917, the said
Letters Patent bearing date the 18th day of December 1918, the said Instructions,
and the said Dormant Commission, and substituting in place of the revoked
documents other provision in the form of the draft of new Letters Patent set out in
the First Schedule to that Order in Council:

Recites Application of Letters Patent, Royal Instructions, and Dormant

Commission to Cook Islands and Niue

AND WHEREAS the said Letters Patent bearing date the 11th day of May
1917, the said Letters Patent bearing date the 18th day of December 1918, the said
Instructions, and the said Dormant Commission extend to the self-governing state
of the Cook Islands and to the self governing state of Niue as part of the law of the
Cook Islands and of Niue, respectively:

Recites Approval by Government of Cook Islands and Government of Niue of draft of new Letters Patent. Effects Revocations

AND WHEREAS approval of the said draft of new Letters Patent has been signified on behalf of the Government of the Cook Islands and the Government of Niue:
NOW, THEREFORE, We do by these presents revoke and determine the said Letters Patent bearing date the 11th day of May 1917, the said Letters Patent bearing date the 18th day of December 1918, the said Instructions, and the said Dormant Commission, but without prejudice to anything lawfully done thereunder, and We do hereby declare that the persons who are members of the body known as the Executive Council of New Zealand immediately before the coming into force of these Our Letters Patent shall be members of Our Executive Council hereby constituted as though they had been appointed thereto under these Our Letters Patent.
AND WE do declare Our will and pleasure as follows –

1 Office of Governor General and Commander-in-Chief constituted

(1) We do hereby constitute, order, and declare that there shall be, in and
over Our Realm of New Zealand, which comprises – (a) New Zealand; and
(b) The self-governing state of the Cook Islands; and
(c) The self-governing state of Niue; and
(d) Tokelau; and
(e) The Ross Dependency, –

Letters Patent 67

a Governor-General and Commander-in-Chief who shall be Our representative in Our Realm of New Zealand, and shall have and may exercise the powers and authorities conferred on him by these Our Letters Patent, but without prejudice to the office, powers or authorities of any other person who has been or may be appointed to represent Us in any part of Our Realm of New Zealand and to exercise powers and authorities on Our behalf.

2 Appointment of Governor-General and Commander-in-Chief

And We do hereby order and declare that Our Governor-General and
Commander-in-Chief (hereinafter called Our Governor-General) shall be
appointed by Us, by Commission under the Seal of New Zealand, and shall hold
office during Our pleasure.

3 Governor-General’s powers and authorities

And We do hereby authorise and empower Our Governor-General, except
as may be otherwise provided by law –
(a) To exercise on Our behalf the executive authority of Our Realm of
New Zealand, either directly or through officers subordinate to Our
Governor-General; and
(b) For greater certainty, but not so as to restrict the generality of the
foregoing provisions of this clause, to do and execute in like manner
all things that belong to the office of Governor-General including
the powers and authorities hereinafter conferred by these Our
Letters Patent.

4 Manner in which Governor-General’s powers and authorities are to be executed

Our Governor-General shall do and execute all the powers and authorities of the Governor-General according to –
(a) The tenor of these Our Letters Patent and of such Commission as may be issued to Our Governor-General under the Seal of New Zealand; and
(b) Such laws as are now or shall hereafter be in force in Our Realm of
New Zealand or in any part thereof.

5 Publication of Governor-General’s Commission

Every person appointed to fill the office of Governor-General shall, before
entering on any of the duties of the office, cause the Commission appointing him
to be Governor-General to be publicly read, in the presence of the Chief Justice, or
some other Judge of the High Court of New Zealand, and of Members of the
Executive Council thereof.

6 Oaths to be taken by Governor-General

Our Governor-General shall, immediately after the public reading of the
Commission appointing him, take –
(a) The Oath of Allegiance in the form for the time being prescribed by
the law of New Zealand; and
(b) The Oath for the due execution of the Office of Governor-General
in the form following –
I, [name], swear that, as Governor-General and Commander-in-Chief
of the Realm of New Zealand, comprising New Zealand; the self­
68 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
governing states of the Cook Islands and Niue; Tokelau; and the Ross Dependency, I will faithfully and impartially serve Her [or His] Majesty [specify the name of the reigning Sovereign, as thus: Queen Elizabeth the Second], Queen of New Zealand [or King of New Zealand], Her [or His] heirs and successors, and the people of the Realm of New Zealand, in accordance with their respective laws and customs. So help me God.
which Oaths the Chief Justice or other Judge in whose presence the Commission is read is hereby required to administer.

7 Constitution of Executive Council

And We do by these presents constitute an Executive Council to advise Us
and Our Governor-General in the Government of Our Realm of New Zealand.

8 Membership of Executive Council

The Executive Council shall consist of those persons who, having been
appointed to the Executive Council from among persons eligible for appointment
under the Constitution Act 1986, are for the time being Our responsible advisers.

9 Quorum of Executive Council

The Executive Council shall not proceed to the despatch of business unless
two Members at the least (exclusive of any Member presiding in the absence of
Our Governor-General) be present throughout the whole of the meeting at which
any such business is despatched, except that in a situation of urgency or emergency,
members may be present by any method of communication that allows each
member to participate effectively during the whole of the meeting.

10 Appointment of Members of Executive Council, etc

And We do hereby authorise and empower Our Governor-General, from
time to time in Our name and on Our behalf, to constitute and appoint under the
Seal of New Zealand, to hold office during pleasure, all such Members of the
Executive Council, Ministers of the Crown, Commissioners, Diplomatic or
Consular Representatives of New Zealand, Principal Representatives of New
Zealand in any other country or accredited to any international organisation, and
other necessary Officers as may be lawfully constituted or appointed by Us.

11 Exercise of Prerogative of Mercy

And We do further authorise and empower Our Governor-General, in Our
name and on Our behalf, to exercise the prerogative of mercy in Our Realm of
New Zealand, except in any part thereof where, under any law now or hereafter
in force, the prerogative of mercy may be exercised in Our name and on Our
behalf by any other person or persons, to the exclusion of Our Governor-General;
and for greater certainty but not so as to restrict the authority hereby conferred,
Our Governor-General may –
(a) Grant, to any person concerned in the commission of any offence
for which he may be tried in any court in New Zealand or in any
other part of Our said Realm to which this clause applies or to any
person convicted of any offence in any such court, a pardon, either
free or subject to lawful conditions; or
(b) Grant, to any person, a respite, either indefinite or for a specified
period, of the execution of any sentence passed on that person in
any court in New Zealand or in any other part of Our said Realm to
which this clause applies; or

Letters Patent 69

(c) Remit, subject to such lawful conditions as he may think fit to impose, the whole or any part of any such sentence or of any penalty or forfeiture otherwise due to Us on account of any offence in respect of which a person has been convicted by any court in New Zealand or in any other part of Our said Realm to which this clause applies.

12 Administrator of the Government

Whenever the Office of Governor-General is vacant, or the holder of the
Office is for any reason unable to perform all or any of the functions of the Office,
We do hereby authorise, empower, and command the Chief Justice of New Zealand
to perform the functions of the Office of Governor-General. If, however, there is
for the time being no Chief Justice able to act as Governor-General, then the next
most senior Judge of the New Zealand judiciary who is able so to act is so
authorised, empowered, and commanded. The Chief Justice or the next most
senior Judge, while performing all or any of the functions of the Office of Governor-
General, is to be known as the Administrator of the Government; and in these
Our Letters Patent every reference to Our Governor-General includes, unless
inconsistent with the context, a reference to Our Administrator of the Government.

13 Oaths to be taken by Administrator of the Government

The said Chief Justice or next most senior Judge of the New Zealand
judiciary shall, on the first occasion on which he is required to act as Administrator
of the Government and before entering on any of the duties of the office of
Governor-General, take the Oaths hereinbefore directed to be taken by Our
Governor-General, which Oaths, with such modifications as are necessary, shall
be administered by some other Judge of the High Court of New Zealand, in the
presence of not less than two Members of the Executive Council.

14 Powers and authorities of Governor-General not abridged

While Our Administrator of the Government is performing all or any of
the functions of the office of Governor-General, the powers and authorities of
Our Governor-General shall not be abridged, altered, or in any way affected,
otherwise than as We may at any time hereafter think proper to direct.

15 [Revoked SR 2006/224]

16 Ministers to keep Governor-General informed

Our Ministers of the Crown in New Zealand shall keep Our Governor-
General fully informed concerning the general conduct of the Government of
Our said Realm, so far as they are responsible therefor, and shall furnish Our
Governor-General with such information as he may request with respect to any
particular matter relating to the Government of Our said Realm.

17 Ministers and others to obey, aid, and assist Governor-General

Our Ministers of the Crown and other Officers, civil and military, and all
other inhabitants of Our Realm of New Zealand, shall obey, aid, and assist Our
Governor-General in the performance of the functions of the office of Governor-
General.
70 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

18 Power reserved to Her Majesty to revoke, alter, or amend the present

Letters Patent

And We do hereby reserve to Ourselves, Our heirs and successors, full
power and authority from time to time to revoke, alter, or amend these Our Letters
Patent as to Us or them shall seem meet.

19 Present Letters Patent to have effect as law

And We do further declare that these Our Letters Patent shall take effect as
part of the law of Our Realm of New Zealand...
IN WITNESS WHEREOF We have caused these Our Letters to be made Patent, and for the greater testimony and validity thereof We have caused the Seal of New Zealand to be affixed to these presents, which We have signed with Our Regal Hand.
GIVEN the 28th day of October in the Year of Our Lord One Thousand Nine
Hundred and Eighty-three and in the 32nd Year of Our Reign.
By Her Majesty’s Command.
71

SEAL OF NEW ZEALAND PROCLAMATION 1977

ELIZABETH R
A PROCLAMATION
WHEREAS there has been passed in the present Session of the Parliament of New Zealand the Seal of New Zealand Act 1977, by which Act the assent of the Parliament of New Zealand was given to the establishment, by Proclamation, by Us and Our Successors of a seal to be known as the Seal of New Zealand for use in relation to New Zealand and all other territories for whose foreign relations Her Majesty’s Government in New Zealand is responsible: And whereas the Government of the Cook Islands and the Government of Niue have concurred in the proposals for the establishment of that Seal:
Now therefore We do hereby proclaim as follows:

1 Title

This Proclamation may be cited as the Seal of New Zealand Proclamation
1977.

2 Establishment of Seal of New Zealand

There shall be a Seal to be known as the Seal of New Zealand for use in
relation to New Zealand and all other territories for whose foreign relations Our
Government in New Zealand is responsible.

3 Use of Seal

(1) The Seal of New Zealand shall be used, in accordance with the Seal of
New Zealand Act 1977, by Us and Our Successors and by the Governor-General.
(2) This Proclamation shall have effect –
(a) Notwithstanding anything contained in Our Warrant bearing date
the 29th day of June 1959; and
(b) Notwithstanding anything contained in the Letters Patent dated
the 11th day of May 1917 and the Instructions passed thereunder.

4 Design and style of Seal

The Seal mentioned in Our said Warrant bearing date the 29th day of June
1959, an impression of which seal is set out in the Schedule hereto, shall be and is
hereby adopted by Us as the Seal of New Zealand.

SCHEDULE [Not reproduced]

72 Niue Laws 2005 Voll

73

ADMINISTRATION ACT 1969

1969/52 (NZ) – 1 January 1971

to real estate

31 Payment of claims where estate

insufficient

32 Administration suits

33 Debts under deeds and simple

contracts to stand in equal degree

34 Charges on property

35-36 [Repealed]

37 Liability of specific devise or bequest

where estate is insufficient

38 Proving executors may exercise powers

39 Interest on legacies and annuities

40 No right of retainer by administrator

41 Rights and liabilities of administrator

42 Liability of agent of administrator

43 Administrator ’s right to distrain

44 Administrator may be required to

exhibit inventory

45 Protection of person acting on

administration

46-48 [Repealed]

49 Following of assets

50 Freedom to exercise remedies

51 Restriction on following assets

52 Liability of person fraudulently

obtaining or retaining estate of

deceased

Powers and Procedure of Court

53 Direction to executor to prove or

renounce

54 Production of instruments purporting

to be testamentary

55 Continuance of legal proceedings

56 Question of fact may be tried by a jury

57 Practice of Court in its administration

jurisdiction

58 [Repealed]

59 Power to make rules

Caveats

60 Caveat may be lodged

61 Where a caveat lodged, Court may

grant order nisi

74 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Miscellaneous Provisions

62 [Repealed]

63 Administration granted to trustee

companies

64-66 [Repealed]

67 Other Acts providing for payment

without administration

68 Bondsmen and sureties deemed to be

trustees

PART 2

ADMINISTRATION GRANTED OUT OF NIUE

69 Interpretation

70 Estate of person dying abroad not to vest

without administration

71 Resealing of probate

72 Seal not to be affixed till fees are paid

and administration bond effected

73 No probate granted out of Niue to be

evidence unless resealed

To consolidate and amend certain enactments relating to the administration of the estates of deceased persons

1 Short title

This is the Administration Act 1969.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“administration” means probate of the will of a deceased person, and
includes letters of administration of the estate of a deceased person,
granted with or without a will annexed, for general, special, or limited
purposes, and in the case of a trustee corporation includes an order to
administer and an election to administer;
“administrator” means any person to whom administration is granted, and
includes a trustee corporation in any case where it is deemed to be an
executor or administrator by reason of having filed an election to
administer;
“Commonwealth” means the Commonwealth of Nations, and includes
every territory for whose international relations the Government of any
country of the Commonwealth is responsible;
“Commonwealth country” means a country that is a member of the
Commonwealth, and includes every territory for whose international
relations the Government of that country is responsible;
“estate” means real and personal property of every kind, including things
in action;
“intestate” includes a person who leaves a will but dies intestate as to some
beneficial interest in his real or personal estate;
“personal chattels”, in relation to any person who has died, means all
vehicles, boats, and aircraft and their accessories, garden effects, horses,
stable furniture and effects, domestic animals, plate, plated articles,
linen, china, glass, books, pictures, prints, furniture, jewellery, articles

Administration Act 1969 75

of household or personal use or ornament, musical and scientific instruments and apparatus, wines, liquors, and consumable stores, which immediately before his death were owned by him or in which immediately before his death he had an interest as grantor under an instrument by way of security, or under an agreement that would have been such a hire purchase agreement if the purchaser were not engaged in the trade or business of selling goods of the same nature or description as the goods referred to in the agreement, but does not include any chattels used exclusively or principally at the death of the deceased for business purposes or money or securities for money;
“real estate” means lands, tenements, and hereditaments, corporeal or incorporeal, and whether in possession, reversion, remainder, or expectancy, and any estate or interest in them or any of them, whether freehold or chattel interests, and any possibility, right, or title of entry or action in or concerning them or any of them;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of the High Court; “Rules” means rules made under the authority of this Act; “securities” includes stocks, funds, shares and convertible notes; “will” includes a codicil.
(2) References to a child or issue living at the death of any person include a child or issue who is conceived but not born at the death but who is subsequently born alive.

3 Act to bind Crown

This Act binds the Government.

4 [Spent]

PART 1
ADMINISTRATION BY ADMINISTRATOR

Grant of Administration

5 Probate jurisdiction

(1) The Court shall continue to have jurisdiction and authority in relation
to the granting and revoking of probate of wills and letters of administration with
or without a will annexed of the estates of deceased persons, and in regard to the
hearing and determining of proceedings relating to testamentary matters and
matters relating to the estates of deceased persons.
(2) Without restricting subsection (1) or any other enactment, the Court
shall have jurisdiction to make a grant of probate or letters of administration in
respect of a deceased person, whether or not the deceased person left any estate in
Niue or elsewhere, and whether or not the person to whom the grant is made is in
Niue.

6 Discretion of Court as to person to whom administration is granted

(1) (a) In granting letters of administration with or without a will annexed,
or an order to administer with or without a will annexed, in respect
of the estate of any deceased person or any part of it, the Court
shall have regard to the rights of all persons interested in the estate
of the deceased person or the proceeds of sale of it, and, in particular,
administration with a will annexed may be granted to a devisee or
legatee, and any such administration may be limited in any way
the Court thinks fit.
76 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Subject to subsection (2) where the deceased died wholly intestate as to his estate, administration shall be granted to some one or more persons beneficially interested in the estate of the deceased, if they make an application for the purpose.
(2) Where by reason of the insolvency of the estate or other special circumstances the Court thinks it necessary or expedient to do so, it may –
(a) Grant administration to such person or persons as it thinks expedient notwithstanding that some other person is appointed an executor or that, apart from this subsection, some other person would by law be entitled to a grant of administration;
(b) Grant probate to one or more of the executors appointed by a will, notwithstanding that some other person or persons may also be appointed as an executor or executors.
(3) A grant may be made under subsection (2) notwithstanding that any person excluded from the grant would be competent to take it.
(4) Before determining to exclude from any such grant any person who, apart from this section, would by law be entitled to, or be included in, the grant, and wishes to have, or to be so included in, the grant, the Court shall have regard to his competency and solvency, his ability effectively to administer the estate, the rights of all persons interested in the estate, and any changes in circumstances between the making of the will (if any) and the time when the Court is asked to make the grant.

7 Administration pending legal proceedings

(1) Where any legal proceedings touching the validity of the will of a
deceased person, or for obtaining, recalling, or revoking any grant of
administration, are pending, the Court may grant administration of the estate of
the deceased to a temporary administrator, who shall, until he is discharged or
removed under section 21, have all the rights and powers of a general administrator,
other than the right of distributing the balance of the estate remaining after payment
of debts, funeral and testamentary expenses, duties, and fees, and every such
temporary administrator shall be subject to the immediate control of the Court
and act under its direction.
(2) The Court may, out of the estate of the deceased, grant to a temporary
administrator appointed under this section reasonable remuneration.

8 Grant of special administration where administrator is out of Niue

(1) (a) If at any time after the death of a person any administrator of his
estate is residing out of Niue, the Court may, on the application of
any creditor or person interested in the estate, grant to him or some
other person special administration of the estate of the deceased in
such form and with such powers as the Court may direct or approve.
(b) Unless the Court otherwise directs, every grant of special
administration shall continue until the administrator to whom the
grant is made is discharged or removed under section 21.
(2) While a grant of special administration of the estate of a deceased person
remains in force the previously subsisting administration of that estate shall be
deemed to be suspended, and the administrator shall not be liable for acts and
things done by the administrator under the grant of special administration.
(3) The Court may, for the purpose of any legal proceedings to which the
administrator under the special administration is a party, order the transfer into
Court of any money or securities belonging to the estate, and all persons shall
obey any such order.

Administration Act 1969 77

(4) If the administrator capable of acting as such returns to and resides within the jurisdiction of the Court while any legal proceedings to which a special administrator is a party are pending, the administrator who so returns may be made a party to the legal proceedings and the Court may order that the costs of and incidental to the special administration and the legal proceedings shall be paid by such person and out of such fund as it may specify.
(5) Nothing in this section shall restrict section 21.

9 Administration during minority of executor

(1) Where a person who is sole executor of a will is at the date of the
testator ’s death a minor who is not entitled to a grant of probate under subsection
(3), administration with the will annexed may be granted to such person as the
Court thinks fit, until the minor becomes entitled to and obtains a grant of probate
to him; and on his attaining full age or sooner becoming entitled to a grant of
probate under that subsection and not before, probate of the will may be granted
to him.
(2) Where a testator by his will appoints a person who at his death is a
minor who is not entitled to a grant of probate under subsection (3) to be an
executor, the appointment shall not operate to transfer any interest in the estate of
the deceased to the minor or to constitute him an administrator for any purpose,
unless and until probate is granted to him under this section.
(3) Where a testator by his will appoints a person who is a minor to be an
executor, probate of the will may be granted to the person if, at the date of the
grant –
(a) The person has attained full age; or
(b) The person has attained the age of 18 years and is or has been
married.
(4) A minor to whom probate is granted under subsection (3) (b) shall have
the same rights, powers, duties, and obligations as executor as he would have if
he were of full age, and shall be liable accordingly for his acts and omissions as
executor.

10 Administration with will annexed

Where the Court grants administration of the estate of a deceased person
with the will annexed, the will of the deceased shall be performed and observed
in like manner as if probate of it had been granted to an executor.

11 Cesser of right of executor to prove

(1) Where a person appointed executor by a will –
(a) Survives the testator but dies without having been granted probate
of the will; or
(b) Is cited to take out probate of the will and does not appear to the
citation; or
(c) Renounces probate of the will, his rights in respect of the
executorship shall wholly cease, and the representation to the
testator and the administration of the testator ’s estate shall devolve
and be committed as if that person had not been appointed executor.
(2) (a) Where a person is appointed by a will to be both executor and trustee
and his rights in respect of the executorship wholly cease under
subsection (1), his rights in respect of the trusteeship shall also
wholly cease and the trusteeship shall devolve or be determined as
if he had not been appointed as trustee.
78 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Nothing in paragraph (a) shall prevent his subsequent appointment as trustee.

12 Withdrawal of renunciation

(1) Notwithstanding section 11, an executor who has renounced probate
may be permitted by the Court to withdraw the renunciation and prove the will.
(2) Where an executor who has renounced probate has been permitted to
withdraw the renunciation and prove the will –
(a) The probate shall take effect and be deemed always to have taken
effect without prejudice to the previous acts and dealings of and
notices to any other person to whom administration has been
granted, and a memorandum of the subsequent probate shall be
endorsed on the original grant of administration;
(b) His rights (if any) in respect of the trusteeship shall revive except
so far as the Court otherwise orders.

13 Executor of executor represents original testator

(1) (a) An executor of a sole or last surviving executor of a testator shall
be the executor of that testator.
(b) A person who does not prove the will of his testator shall be deemed
not to be an executor notwithstanding his appointment as such by
the will, and in the case of an executor who on his death leaves
surviving him some other executor of his testator who at the time
of the testator ’s death has not proved but who afterwards proves
the will of that testator, paragraph (a) shall cease to apply when
probate to the surviving executor is granted.
(2) So long as the chain of representation is unbroken, the last executor in
the chain is the executor of every preceding testator.
(3) The chain of representation is broken by –
(a) The failure to leave a will; or
(b) The failure of a testator to appoint an executor; or
(c) The failure to obtain probate of a will,
but is not broken by a temporary grant of administration if probate is subsequently
granted.
(4) Every person in the chain of representation to a testator –
(a) Has the same rights in respect of the estate of that testator as the
original executor would have had if living; and
(b) Is, to the extent to which the estate of that testator has come to his
hands, answerable as if he were an original executor.

14 [Repealed]

15 Administration bond

(1) (a) Every person to whom a grant of administration (other than the
probate of a will) is made shall, previously to the issue of it, execute
a bond to the Registrar to enure for the benefit of the Registrar for
the time being, with 2 sureties approved by the Court, conditioned
for duly collecting, getting in, and administering the estate of the
deceased, which bond shall be in such form as may be prescribed
by rules.

Administration Act 1969 79

(b) It shall not be necessary for any trustee, corporation or any person obtaining administration to the use or for the benefit of Her Majesty, to execute any such bond, and in any case in which the Court is willing to dispense with sureties under subsection (2) it may dispense with the bond.
(2) In every case in which a bond is required under subsection (1), the
bond shall be in a penalty equal to the amount under which the estate of the
deceased is sworn, if that amount does not exceed 20,000 dollars, and shall be in a
penalty of 20,000 dollars where the amount exceeds that sum; but the Court may
dispense with one or both of the sureties, or direct that the penalty be reduced in
amount, and may also if it thinks fit direct that more bonds than one be given, so
as to limit the liability of any surety to such amount as the Court thinks reasonable.
(3) The bond required under subsection (2) shall relate to both real and
personal estate.
(4) The Court may in place of a bond, accept a security in favour of the
Registrar of any corporation or guarantee society approved by Cabinet.
(5) Every such security shall be in such form and under such regulations
as the rules direct.

16 Proceedings if condition of bond broken

The Court may, on being satisfied that the condition of any such bond or
security has been broken, order the Registrar to assign the bond or security to
some person to be named in the order and that person or his administrator may
thereupon sue upon the bond or security in his own name as if the bond or security
had been originally given to him, and shall be entitled to recover thereon as trustee
for all persons interested the full amount recoverable in respect of any breach of
the condition of the bond or security.

17 Administration as evidence

Every administration of a will or with a will annexed shall be evidence of
that will upon all questions concerning real estate in the same manner and to the
same extent as in questions concerning personal estate, and every administration
shall, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be sufficient evidence of the death
and the date of the death of the testator or intestate.

18 Certificates of administration

(1) Subject to subsection (2) at any time after the grant of the relevant
administration the Registrar may, on the request of the administrator, issue under
his hand and seal such number of certificates of administration, in the form set
out in the Schedule, as may be required.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) (a) Every such certificate shall, in the absence of proof to the contrary,
be sufficient evidence of the death and the date of death of the
testator or intestate and of the grant of administration to the
administrator for all purposes including registering the
administrator as proprietor of any estate or interest in any land or
of any securities issued by or property in any bank or company or
body or association.
(b) No bank or company or body or association to which any such
certificate is produced shall be concerned to inquire concerning the
trusts on which the administrator holds any such land or securities
or property, or as to the authority to transfer or deal with the same.
80 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(4) The fee payable to the Registrar in respect of each such certificate shall be $1 or such other amount as may be prescribed by the Cabinet.

19 Proceedings where executor neglects to prove will

(1) In any case where any executor named in a will neglects or refuses to
prove the will, or to renounce probate of it, within 3 months from the death of the
testator, the Court may, upon the application of any other executor or executors or
of any person interested in the estate or of any creditor of the testator, grant an
order nisi calling upon the executor who so neglects or refuses to show cause why
probate of the will should not be granted to that executor alone or with any other
executor or executors or, in the alternative, why administration should not be
granted to the applicant or some other person.
(2) Upon proof (whether by affidavit or otherwise) of service of the order,
or upon the Court dispensing with service of the order, if the executor who is so
called upon does not appear or upon cause being shown, the Court may make
such order for the administration of the estate, and as to costs, as appears just.

20 [Repealed by 2004/170]

21 Discharge or removal of administrator

(1) Where an administrator is absent from Niue for 12 months without
leaving a lawful attorney, or desires to be discharged from the office of
administrator, or becomes incapable of acting as administrator or unfit to so act,
or where it becomes expedient to discharge or remove an administrator, the Court
may discharge or remove that administrator, and may appoint any person to be
administrator in his place, on such terms and conditions in all respects as the
Court thinks fit.
(2) The administrator so removed or discharged shall, from the date of
that order, cease to be liable for acts and things done after that date.
(3) Upon any administrator being discharged or removed as aforesaid
(whether or not any such administrator is appointed) all the estate and rights of
the previous administrator or administrators which were vested in him or them
as such shall become and be vested in the continuing administrator or
administrators (including any administrator appointed under subsection (1) who
shall have the same powers, authorities, discretions, and duties, and may in all
respects act, as if he or they had been originally appointed as the administrator or
administrators.
(4) This section shall, with all necessary modifications, extend to the case
where an administrator dies, and the powers and authorities hereby conferred
may be exercised and shall take effect accordingly.
(5) Nothing in this section shall restrict section 8.

Administering of Estates

22 Interim vesting of estate where no executor appointed

(1) Subject to this Act and any other Act, where a person dies without
leaving a will that effectively appoints an executor, his estate shall, until
administration is granted in respect of it, vest in the Crown in the same manner
and to the same extent as formerly in England in the case of personal property it
vested in the ordinary.
(2) While any estate remains vested in the Crown under this section, the
Crown Proceedings Act 1950 shall apply to the service on the Crown of notices
and documents relating to the estate as if they related to civil proceedings instituted
against the Crown.

Administration Act 1969 81

23 Executor not to act while another administrator is in office

Subject to this Act and any other Act, where administration has been granted
in respect of any part of the estate of a deceased person, and is not for the time
being suspended, no person other than the administrator of that part of the estate
shall have power to bring an action or otherwise act as administrator of the
deceased person in respect of the estate comprised in or affected by the grant until
the grant has been recalled or revoked.

24 Estate to vest in administrator

(1) (a) Immediately upon the grant of administration of the estate of any
deceased person, all the estate then unadministered of that person,
whether held by him beneficially or held by him in trust, shall vest
in the administrator to whom the administration is granted for all
the estate therein of that person.
(b) Nothing in paragraph (a) shall affect the earlier vesting in an
executor by operation of law.
(2) The title of every administrator to any part of the estate of a deceased
person shall relate back to and be deemed to have arisen immediately upon the
death of the deceased person, as if there had been no interval of time between the
death and the grant of administration.
(3) If there are concurrently more administrators than one of any part of
the estate that part shall vest in them as joint tenants.

25 How estate to be held by administrator

Subject to this Act, the administrator shall hold –
(a) The estate of any person who dies or who has died leaving a will
according to the trusts and dispositions of the will, so far as the will
affects that estate;
(b) The estate of any person who dies intestate as to that estate under
Part 3.

26 Estate to be assets for payment of debts

The whole of the estate of every deceased person shall be assets in the
hands of his administrator for the payment of all duties and fees payable under
any Act imposing or charging duties or fees on the estates of deceased persons,
and for the payment in the ordinary course of administration of his debts and of
debts properly incurred by his administrator; and for those purposes the
administrator may, in as full and effectual a manner in law as the testator or intestate
could have done in his lifetime, sell, lease (with or without an optional or
compulsory purchasing clause), or mortgage (with or without a power of sale),
the estate, or any part of it.

27 Power of sale on intestacy

(1) On the death of a person intestate as to any real or personal estate, his
administrator shall have power to sell that real estate and to call in, sell, and convert
into money such part of that personal estate as may not consist of money, with
power to postpone the sale, calling in, and conversion for such a period as the
administrator, without being liable to account, may think proper, and so that, unless
required for purposes of administration owing to want of other assets, personal
chattels be not sold under this section except for special reason.
(2) This section shall have effect notwithstanding that the administrator
has ceased to hold the real or personal estate as administrator and holds it as
trustee.
82 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) Where the deceased leaves a will this section shall have effect subject to the will.

28 Method of sale or lease

(1) Sections 14 to 18 of the Trustee Act 1956 shall, so far as they are applicable
and with any necessary modifications, apply to any sale or lease under sections
26 and 27 of this Act as if the sale or lease were under sections 14 to 18 of the
Trustee Act 1956.
(2) Nothing in this section shall restrict the term of any lease which may
be granted under section 26.
(3) Land of any value may be sold or leased under section 26, or may be
sold under section 27 without the consent of the Court.

29 Administrator to represent real estate

In all actions concerning the real estate of a deceased person, his
administrator shall represent his real estate and the persons interested in it in the
same manner and to the same extent as, in actions concerning personal estate, the
administrator represents that estate and the persons interested in it.

30 Rights and duties of administrator as to real estate

The administrator of any deceased person shall have the same rights and
be subject to the same duties and liabilities with respect to the real estate of that
person as he has and is subject to with respect to the personal estate of that person,
and shall perform the duties imposed on the administrator by any Act imposing
or charging duties or fees or liabilities on the estates of deceased persons.

31 Payment of claims where estate insufficient

Where the estate of any deceased person is insufficient to pay his debts,
funeral, and testamentary expenses in full, it shall be lawful for the administrator
to apply that estate under the priorities that would be applicable if it were being
administered under Part 17 of the Insolvency Act 1967 (NZ), without the
administrator being under any obligation to have recourse to that Part or to
administer that estate under it and any surplus shall be held for the person or
persons lawfully entitled.

32 Administration suits

(1) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(2) In any action or other proceeding for the administration by the Court
of the estate of any deceased person, no court shall have jurisdiction to order or
allow payment of costs out of the estate to the party responsible for the
commencement or continuance of the action or proceeding, unless the Court first
certifies that there were reasonable grounds for the action being commenced or
continued, and then only to the extent to which the continuance was necessary.

33 Debts under deeds and simple contracts to stand in equal degree

(1) Subject to this Act and any other Act, in the administration of the estate
of every person who has died no debt or liability of the person shall be entitled to
any priority or preference by reason merely that it arises under a bond, deed, or
instrument under seal; but all the creditors of that person shall be treated as
standing in equal degree and be paid accordingly out of the assets of the deceased
person, whether those assets are legal or equitable.

Administration Act 1969 83

(2) Nothing in subsection (1) shall prejudice or affect any lien, charge, mortgage, or other security which any creditor may hold or be entitled to for payment of his debt or liability.

34 Charges on property

(1) (a) Where a person dies possessed of, or entitled to, or under a general
power of appointment by his will disposes of, an interest in property,
or where an interest in property passes by survivorship on the death
of a person, and at the time of his death the interest is charged with
the payment of money, whether by way of mortgage, charge, or
otherwise, and the deceased has not by will, deed, or other
document signified a contrary or other intention, the interest so
charged shall, as between the different persons claiming through
the deceased, be primarily liable for payment of all amounts charged
thereon; and every part of the said interest, according to its value,
shall bear a proportionate part of the amounts charged on the whole.
(b) Where a person dies possessed of or entitled to an interest in any
personal chattels that passes under the will or on the intestacy of
the person to the person’s husband or wife, nothing in this
subsection shall apply to that interest in those personal chattels.
(2) Such a contrary or other intention shall not be deemed to be signified –
(a) By a general direction for payment of debts or of all the debts of the
testator out of his personal estate, or his residuary real and personal
estate, or his residuary real estate, or his residuary personal estate;
or
(b) By a charge of debts upon any such estate –
unless that intention is further signified by words expressly or by necessary
implication referring to all or some part of the charge on the interest in property.
(3) Nothing in this section shall affect the right of a person entitled to the
payment with which the interest in property is charged to obtain payment or
satisfaction out of the other assets of the estate or otherwise.

35-36 [Repealed by 2004/270]

37 Liability of specific devise or bequest where estate is insufficient

If any testator ’s estate primarily liable for the payment of his debts is
insufficient for that purpose, each of his specifically devised or bequeathed estates
(if more than one) shall be liable to make good the deficiency, in the proportion
that the value of each of those estates bears to the aggregate value of the specifically
devised or bequeathed estates of the testator.

38 Proving executors may exercise powers

Where probate is granted to one or some of 2 or more persons named as
executors, whether or not power is reserved to the others or other to prove, all the
powers which are conferred by law or by the will on the administrator may be
exercised by the proving executor or executors for the time being, and shall be as
effectual as if all the persons named as executors had concurred in it.

39 Interest on legacies and annuities

(1) In any case where a legacy is charged upon both land and chattels,
unless the will otherwise provides, interest shall be payable on the legacy and be
a charge on the land and chattels under the rules of law that would apply if the
legacy were charged upon the land only.
84 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) While interest is payable on any legacy or on any arrears of an annuity, under the will or instrument under which the legacy or annuity is payable or any enactment or rule of law, unless the will or instrument otherwise provides or the Court otherwise orders, the interest on the legacy or arrears of the annuity shall be payable at the rate for the time being prescribed by Cabinet, and while no such regulation is in force at the rate of 5 percent per annum.
(3) Where an administrator (under any power conferred on him in that behalf) appropriates any property in or towards satisfaction of any legacy (other than an annuity), the legatee shall be entitled to the income from the property so appropriated, and interest shall not be payable out of any other part of the estate on so much of the legacy as has been satisfied by the appropriation.

40 No right of retainer by administrator

No person, being a creditor in his own right or as a trustee of any estate of
which he is administrator, shall, by virtue of his office as administrator, have any
right of retainer in priority to the other creditors of the estate in respect of any
debt due to him; but every such creditor or administrator shall rank with other
creditors, but without prejudice to any preferential claim or security which as a
creditor he might have been able to enforce if he had not been the administrator.

41 Rights and liabilities of administrator

Every person to whom administration of the estate of a deceased person is
granted, other than an executor, shall, subject to the limitations contained in the
grant, have the same rights and liabilities and be accountable in like manner as if
he were the executor of the deceased.

42 Liability of agent of administrator

No person appointed an administrator upon an application made by him
as the attorney or agent for an administrator absent from Niue, shall be liable to
account or pay money, or transfer property, to any one in respect of his
administratorship excepting only to the administrator whose attorney or agent
he was, or to any person who, after his appointment as administrator upon an
application so made, is appointed administrator of the same estate.

43 Administrator’s right to distrain

(1) An administrator may distrain for arrears of a rentcharge due or
accruing to the deceased in his lifetime on the land affected or charged with it, so
long as the land remains in the possession of the person liable to pay the rentcharge
or of the persons deriving title under him, and in like manner as the deceased
might have done had he been living.
(2) An administrator may distrain upon land for arrears of rent due or
accruing to the deceased in like manner as the deceased might have done had he
been living. Any such arrears may be distrained for after the termination of the
lease or tenancy as if the term or interest had not determined, if the distress is
made –
(a) Within 6 months after the termination of the lease or tenancy; and
(b) During the continuance of the possession of the lessee or tenant
from whom the arrears were due.
(3) The enactments relating to distress for rent shall apply to any distress
made under subsection (2).

Administration Act 1969 85

44 Administrator may be required to exhibit inventory

Every administrator shall, when required by the Court so to do, exhibit on
oath in the Court a true and perfect inventory and account of the estate of the
deceased, and the Court shall have power to require administrators to bring in
inventories.

45 Protection of persons acting on administration

(1) Every administrator or person who makes any payment or disposition
or assumes any liability, or who permits any payment or disposition to be made,
or who does any act, or who permits any act to be done, in good faith under an
administration shall, notwithstanding any defect or circumstances whatsoever
affecting the validity of the administration or its subsequent revocation, have the
same indemnity and protection in so doing and in respect of all commission and
remuneration earned by him in so doing, as he would if the administration were
valid and not revoked.
(2) Where an administration is revoked, all payments and dispositions
made in good faith to an administrator before the revocation shall be valid
discharges to the person making the same; and the administrator who acted under
the revoked administration may retain and reimburse himself out of the estate
that comes into his hands in respect of any acts, payments, dispositions, liabilities,
commission, and remuneration in respect of which he is indemnified as aforesaid
or which the person to whom administration is afterwards granted might have
properly made.
(3) Nothing in subsection (1) shall affect or prejudice the rights of any
person entitled to any money or property that has been the subject of a payment
or disposition to which that subsection relates against any person (other than the
administrator in that capacity) to whom the payment or disposition has been made,
but the person so entitled shall have the same remedy against the person (other
than the administrator in that capacity) to whom the payment or disposition was
made as he would have had against the administrator if the payment or disposition
had not been made.
(4) Nothing in this section shall restrict section 51.

46-48 [Repealed by 2004/270]

49 Following of assets

(1) In any case where an administrator or trustee has made a distribution
of any assets forming part of the estate of any deceased person or subject to any
trust and there is nothing in any Act to prevent the distribution from being
disturbed, the Court may –
(a) Make, subject to such terms and conditions as it thinks fit, in respect
of any interest in any such assets that is for the time being retained
by the person to whom those assets were distributed or his
administrator or any person who has received any interest in those
assets from either of them otherwise than in good faith and for full
valuable consideration an order on any claim to which section 35
of the Trustee Act 1956 applies, or an order requiring the transfer of
payment of any such interest in any such assets to the administrator
of the deceased or the trustee or to any person who under any
enactment or rule of law has a right to follow the assets;
(b) Order that any person to whom any assets were so distributed or
his administrator shall pay to any applicant for an order on any
86 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
claim to which section 35 of the Trustee Act 1956 applies, or to the administrator of the deceased or the trustee or to any person who under any enactment or rule of law has a right to follow the assets a sum not exceeding the net value of the assets at the date of the distribution, or in a case where full valuable consideration has not been given a sum not exceeding the amount by which that net value exceeds the value of the consideration at that date, together (if the Court thinks equitable) with interest on it from that date until the date of the order at such rate as the Court may specify;
(c) Order that any person who has received any interest in any such assets from the person to whom they were distributed or his administrator, otherwise than in good faith and for full valuable consideration, shall pay to any applicant for an order on any claim to which section 35 of the Trustee Act 1956 applies, or to the administrator of the deceased or the trustee, or to any person who under any enactment or rule of law has a right to follow the assets, a sum not exceeding the net value of that interest at the date of the distribution, or in a case where full valuable consideration has not been given a sum not exceeding the amount by which that net value exceeds the value of the consideration at that date, together (if the Court thinks equitable) with interest on it from that date until the date of the order at such rate as the Court may specify;
(d) In making any such order fix such terms and conditions as the Court thinks fit and for the purpose of giving effect to any such order, make such further order as it thinks fit.
(2) The remedies given to any person by subsection (1) are in addition to all other rights and remedies (if any) available to that person, and nothing in that subsection shall restrict any such other rights and remedies.
(3) Subject to subsection (4), no application for an order under subsection
(1) shall be heard by the Court –
(a) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(b) In the case of an application to which section 50 (b) (i) applies, unless
that application is made within 1 year after the satisfaction by the
administrator or trustee of any claim in respect of any right or
remedy against him;
(c) In any other case, unless the application for an order under
subsection (1) is made within the time within which the applicant
could have enforced his claim in respect of the estate without special
leave of the Court if the assets had not been distributed:
Provided that, with the special leave of the Court, the application may be
heard by the Court on an application made within the time within which the
applicant could have enforced his claim in respect of the estate with special leave
of the Court if the assets had not been distributed.
(4) Notwithstanding subsection (3), in any case where an administrator or
trustee has made a distribution of any assets forming part of the estate of any
deceased person or subject to any trust, and any person who is entitled to apply
for an order under subsection (1) has, within the time specified in subsection (3),
made an application to the Court for an order on any claim to which section 35 of
the Trustee Act 1956 applies, and that person was not aware of the distribution at
the time when he made that application, that person or any other person on whose
behalf that application is deemed to be made, may apply to the Court under
subsection (1), and the application may be heard by the Court after the expiration

Administration Act 1969 87

of the period prescribed by subsection (3) if it is made within 6 months after the date on which that person first became aware of the distribution.

50 Freedom to exercise remedies

Notwithstanding any rule of law to the contrary, in any case where an
administrator or trustee has made a distribution of any assets forming part of the
estate of any deceased person or subject to any trust –
(a) Any person may exercise the remedies (if any) given to him by
section 49 (1) and all other rights and remedies available to him
(including all rights which he may have to follow assets and any
money or property into which they have been converted) without
first exercising the rights and remedies (if any) available to him
against the administrator or the trustee in consequence of the
making of the distribution;
(b) If any person exercises any right or remedy available against the
administrator or the trustee in consequence of the distribution of
any such assets, the administrator or trustee may –
(i) apply to the Court for any order which may be made under
section 49 (1);
(ii) in any proceedings against him in respect of the exercise of
any such right or remedy, by leave of the Court and in
accordance with the rules of court relating to such notices, issue
a third party notice against any person against whom he may
apply for an order under subparagraph (i).

51 Restriction on following assets

In any case where an administrator or trustee has made a distribution of
any assets forming part of the estate of any deceased person or subject to any
trust, relief (whether under section 49 (1) or in equity or otherwise) against any
person other than the administrator or trustee or in respect of any interest of any
such person in any assets so distributed and in any money or property into which
they have been converted, may be denied wholly or in part, if –
(a) The person from whom relief is sought received the assets or interest
in good faith and has altered his position in the reasonably held
belief that the distribution was properly made and would not be
set aside; and
(b) In the opinion of the Court it is inequitable to grant relief or to grant
relief in full, as the case may be.

52 Liability of person fraudulently obtaining or retaining estate of deceased

If any person other than the administrator, to the defrauding of creditors
or without full valuable consideration, obtains or receives or holds any part of the
estate of a deceased person or effects the release of any debt or liability due to the
estate of the deceased, he shall be charged as executor in his own wrong to the
extent of the estate received or coming into his hands, or the debt or liability
released, after deducting –
(a) Any debt for valuable consideration and without fraud due to him
from the deceased person at the time of his death which might
properly be retained by an administrator; and
(b) Any payment made by him which might properly be made by an
administrator.
88 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Powers and Procedure of Court

53 Direction to executor to prove or renounce

The Court shall have power to direct any person named as executor in a
will to prove or renounce probate of the will, and (subject to this Act and any
other enactment and the Rules) to do such other things as it thinks fit concerning
the granting and revocation of administration, and the hearing and determination
of proceedings relating to testamentary matters and matters relating to the estates
of deceased persons.

54 Production of instruments purporting to be testamentary

The Court may, whether any suit or other proceeding is or is not pending
with respect to any administration, order any person to produce any paper or
writing, being or purporting to be testamentary, which may be shown to be in the
possession or under the control of that person; and if it is not shown that any such
paper or writing is in the possession or under the control of any person, but it
appears that there are reasonable grounds for believing that he has knowledge of
any such paper or writing, the Court may direct that person to attend for the
purpose of being examined in open court, or upon interrogatories, respecting the
same; and that person shall be bound to answer any such questions or
interrogatories, and, if so ordered, to produce and bring in any such paper or
writing, and shall be subject to the like process of contempt in case of default in
not attending or in not answering any such questions or interrogatories, or not
bringing in any such paper or writing, as he would have been subject to in case he
had been a party to a suit in the Court and had made any such default; and the
costs of any such suit or proceeding shall be in the discretion of the Court.

55 Continuance of legal proceedings

If, while any legal proceeding is pending in any court by or against an
administrator to whom a temporary administration has been granted, that
administration is revoked, the Court may order that the proceeding be continued
by or against the new administrator in like manner as if the same had been
originally commenced by or against him, but subject to such conditions and
variations, if any, as that court directs.

56 Question of fact may be tried by a jury

(1) If any question of fact arises in any proceeding under this Act, the Court
may cause the same to be tried by a jury before the Court itself, or before any
Judge of the Court, and may settle an issue for that purpose.
(2) In every such case the subsequent proceedings in respect of that issue
shall be the same as if it had been settled in an ordinary action.

57 Practice of Court in its administration jurisdiction

The practice of the Court in regard to administration shall, except where
otherwise provided, be regulated, so far as the circumstances of the case will admit,
by the practice of the Court.

58 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Administration Act 1969 89

59 Power to make rules

Cabinet may make rules of Court, including rules –
(a) Prescribing the forms of administration;
(b) Prescribing the practice in obtaining a grant of administration, and
the procedure and practice of the Court and the duties of the
Registrar;
(c) Regulating the procedure and practice of the Court with respect to
non-contentious or common form probate business;
(d) Regulating the procedure and practice of the Court with respect to
contentious probate business;
(e) Regulating the practice and procedure of the Court in relation to
the resealing of probates or letters of administration under Part 2,
and in particular for the purpose of imposing upon persons
applying under it for the resealing of probates or letters of
administration, or relieving any such persons from, any
requirements that may be imposed upon persons applying to the
Court for original grants of probate or letters of administration;
(f) Prescribing orders of priority among applicants for administration
which shall apply unless the Court in special circumstances
otherwise directs;
(g) Generally for carrying the provisions of this Act into effect.

60 Caveat may be lodged

Caveats

(1) Any person may lodge with the Registrar a caveat against any application for administration at any time previous to the granting of administration, and every such caveat shall set forth the name of the person lodging it, and an address within Niue at which notices may be served on him.
(2) Every such caveat shall, unless application for administration is sooner
made, lapse upon the expiration of one year from the date of the lodging of the
caveat.
(3) (a) Any such caveat may be withdrawn by the caveator at any time by
notice in writing lodged with the Registrar.
(b) A copy of every such notice shall be served on any person who has
applied for administration or to whom an order nisi, under section
61 has been granted.
(4) Nothing in this section shall prevent any person who has lodged a caveat
from lodging a subsequent caveat, whether or not any caveat previously lodged
has lapsed or been withdrawn.

61 Where a caveat lodged, Court may grant order nisi

In every case where a caveat has been lodged and has neither lapsed nor
been withdrawn, the following provisions shall apply –
(a) The Court may, upon application on behalf of the person applying
for administration, supported by affidavits upon which, if there
had been no caveat, administration would have been granted, make
an order nisi for the grant of administration to the person applying,
and every such order shall name a time and place for showing cause
against the same, and the Court may enlarge any such order;
(b) Every such order nisi, and every order enlarging the same, shall be
served on the caveator by delivering a copy of the same at the
address mentioned in his caveat;
90 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) If before the day named in the order nisi or the day to which the order is enlarged the caveat is withdrawn, the order nisi may be made absolute at any time thereafter;
(d) In any case to which paragraph (c) does not apply, if on the day named in the order nisi, or on the day to which the order is enlarged, the caveator does not appear, the order nisi may be made absolute, upon an affidavit of service; but if the caveator appears, the hearing shall be conducted in the same manner as nearly as may be as in an ordinary action, and the Court may order –
(i) that the order nisi be made absolute or discharged; or
(ii) that the application for administration be made in solemn form,
and any order made under subparagraph (i) or (ii) may be with or
without costs as may be just, and, if the Court so directs, those costs
may be paid out of the estate;
(e) Upon the hearing of the order nisi the parties may, subject to the
Rules, verify their cases in whole or in part by affidavit, but so that
the deponent in every such affidavit shall, on the application of the
opposite party, be subject to be cross-examined by or on behalf of
the opposite party orally in open court, and after cross-examination
may be re-examined orally in open court by or on behalf of the
party by whom the affidavit was filed.

Miscellaneous Provisions

62 [Repealed by 2004/270]

63 Administration granted to trustee companies

(1) No grant of probate of the will of any deceased person or letters of
administration of the estate of a deceased person, either with or without a will
annexed, shall be made to any company unless the company is expressly authorised
by an Act to apply for and obtain the grant.
(2) A grant of probate or letters of administration to a syndic of a company
shall be deemed to be a grant to that company; and where a power is granted to a
company or to the directors of a company by will to nominate any person as
executor of the will, a grant to a person so nominated shall be deemed to be a
grant to the company.
(3) Nothing in this section shall –
(a) Prevent the grant of probate of the will of any deceased person to
any company or to a syndic of the company in any case where the
company is appointed as executor of the will and the actual
document providing for the appointment was made before 1
January 1963;
(b) Prevent the grant of probate of the will of any deceased person to
any person nominated as executor of the will by a company or the
directors of a company pursuant to a power granted by any
testamentary instrument, if the actual document granting the power
was made before 1 January 1963;
(c) Prevent the resealing in Niue of probate or letters of administration
granted to a company in any other country;
(d) Affect any grant of probate or letters of administration subsisting
at 1 January 1971.

64-66 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Administration Act 1969 91

67 Other Acts providing for payment without administration

Nothing in this Act shall affect the powers of any person or body to make
any payment to, or register any person to be, the owner of any property under
any enactment authorising the payment of money belonging to the estate of a
deceased person without requiring administration of the estate to be obtained.

68 Bondsmen and sureties deemed to be trustees

Every person who, in the capacity of bondsman or surety for another,
receives money or other property belonging to the estate of any deceased person
shall be deemed to be a trustee within the meaning of the Trustee Act 1956 in
respect of that money or property, and may under that Act apply for relief and to
be discharged from the custody of the money or property.

69 Interpretation

PART 2
ADMINISTRATION GRANTED OUT OF NIUE
(1) For the purposes of this Part “probate or letters of administration” includes an exemplification of any probate or letters of administration, or a duplicate of it sealed with the seal of the court granting the same, or a copy certified as correct by or under the authority of the court granting the same, and also includes an exemplification or a copy certified by or under the authority of any court, or a duplicate sealed under the seal of any court, of any instrument which is filed in or issued out of that court and which within the jurisdiction of that court operates to make any person the administrator of any property of a deceased person as if probate or letters of administration had been granted to him by that court.
(2) The filing in or the issuing out of any court of any instrument which operates to make any person an administrator in the manner described in subsection (1) shall be deemed to be equivalent to the granting of probate or letters of administration by that court to that person.

70 Estate of person dying abroad not to vest without administration

(1) Estate in Niue belonging to any person who dies abroad shall not vest
in any person under any bequest or devise, or under an intestacy, or by inheritance,
until administration of that estate is obtained in Niue; or, if probate or letters of
administration of the estate have been granted in any place out of Niue, unless
the probate or letters of administration are resealed in Niue as provided in this
Part.
(2) Upon the estate in Niue becoming legally vested under this section, the legal estate shall vest as from the time of the death of the person from whom it is obtained.

71 Resealing of probate

(1) Where any probate or letters of administration granted in a competent
court in any country are produced to and a copy deposited with the Registrar of
the Court the probate or letters of administration may be sealed with the seal of
the Court, and shall have the like force and effect and have the same operation in
Niue, and every executor and administrator thereunder shall perform the same
duties and be subject to the same liabilities, as if the probate or letters of
administration had been originally granted by the Court.
(2) Nothing in this section shall prevent the Court from making an
independent grant of administration in Niue.
92 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

72 Seal not to be affixed till fees are paid and administration bond effected (1) The seal of the Court shall not be affixed to any probate or letters of administration granted in any Commonwealth country (other than Niue) or in the Republic of Ireland, or by a competent court in any other country, so as to give operation as if the grant had been made by the Court, until all such fees have been paid as would have been payable if the probate or letters of administration had been originally granted by the Court ; and, further, no such letters of administration shall be so sealed until such bond is entered into as would have been required if

the letters had been originally granted by the Court:
(2) The Court may if it thinks fit dispense with the bond or reduce the
amount of the penalty thereunder.
(3) Where letters of administration are at any time granted to any Public
Trustee or other like public official of any Commonwealth country (other than
Niue) or of the Republic of Ireland or of any other country to which section 71 is
declared to apply, it shall not be necessary, upon the resealing in Niue of the letters
of administration, for the Public Trustee or other official, as the case may be, to
execute any such bond.

73 No probate granted out of Niue to be evidence unless resealed

Probate or letters of administration granted in any place out of Niue shall
not be received in evidence of the title of any person to any estate in Niue until the
probate or letters of administration are resealed in Niue as provided in this Part.

74 Effect of sections 70 and 73

Nothing in sections 70 and 73 shall restrict any other enactment relating to
the payment or devolution of any estate without administration.
PART 3
DISTRIBUTION OF INTESTATE ESTATES

75-76 [Repealed by 2004/270]

77 Succession on intestacy

Where any person dies intestate as to any real or personal estate, that estate
shall be distributed in the manner or be held on the trusts mentioned in this section,
namely –
(a) If the intestate leaves a husband or wife, the surviving husband or wife shall take the personal chattels absolutely and, in addition, the residue of the estate shall stand charged with the payment of a sum of $12,000 to the surviving husband or wife with interest on it from the date of the death until paid or appropriated, at the rate from time to time prescribed by or under section 39, and, subject to providing for that sum and the interest on it, the residue of the estate shall be held –
(i) if the intestate leaves issue, in trust as to one-third for the
surviving husband or wife absolutely, and as to the other two-
thirds on the statutory trusts for the issue of the intestate;
(ii) if the intestate leaves no issue, in trust as to two-thirds for the
surviving husband or wife absolutely, and as to the other one-
third if the intestate leaves both parents, in trust for the father
and mother in equal shares absolutely or, if the intestate leaves
only one parent, in trust for the surviving father or mother
absolutely;

Administration Act 1969 93

(iii) if the intestate leaves no issue or parent, in trust for the surviving husband or wife absolutely;
(b) If the intestate leaves issue but no husband or wife, the estate shall be held on the statutory trusts for the issue of the intestate;
(c) If the intestate leaves no husband or wife or issue but a parent or parents, the estate shall be held in trust for the parents in equal shares if they both survive the intestate but if only one of them survives the intestate for that one;
(d) If the intestate leaves no husband or wife or issue or parent, the
estate shall be held in trust for the following persons living at the
death of the intestate, and in the following order and manner,
namely:
Firstly, on the statutory trusts for the brothers and sisters (whether
of full or of half blood) of the intestate; but if no person takes an
absolutely vested interest under such trusts; then
Secondly, in trust for the grandparents of the intestate and, if more
than one survive the intestate, in equal shares; but if there is no
member of this class; then
Thirdly, on the statutory trusts for the uncles and aunts of the
intestate, being brothers and sisters (whether of full or of half blood)
of a parent of the intestate;
(e) In default of any person taking an absolute interest under the
foregoing provisions, the estate shall belong to the Crown as bona

vacantia, and in place of any right to escheat; and the Crown may

(without prejudice to any other powers), out of the whole or any
part of the property devolving on it, provide for dependants,
whether kindred or not, of the intestate, and other persons for whom
the intestate might reasonably have been expected to make
provision.

78 Statutory trusts in favour of issue and other classes of relatives

(1) Where the estate of any intestate, or any part of it, is directed to be held
on the statutory trusts for the issue of the intestate, the same shall be held upon the following trusts, namely –
(a) In trust, in equal shares if more than one, for all or any the children
or child of the intestate, living at the death of the intestate, who
attain full age or marry under that age, and for all or any of the
issue living at the death of the intestate who attain full age or marry
under that age of any child of the intestate who predeceases the
intestate, the said issue to take through all degrees, according to
their stocks, in equal shares if more than one, the share which their
parent would have taken if living at the death of the intestate, and
so that no issue shall take whose parent takes an absolutely vested
interest:
Provided that if any person capable of taking under this paragraph
(including this proviso) dies before taking an absolutely vested
interest leaving any child or children who shall be living at the
expiration of 21 years from the death of the intestate or who shall
sooner attain full age or marry under that age, that child or those
children shall take, in equal shares if more than one, the share which
his, her, or their parent would have taken if he or she had not so
died;
94 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) The statutory power of advancement, and the statutory provisions which relate to maintenance, education, and benefit, and the accumulation of surplus income, shall apply, and when a person becomes entitled to a vested share or interest under the statutory trusts, that person shall be entitled on attaining the age of 18 years or sooner marrying to give a valid receipt for his share or interest;
(c) The administrator may permit any minor who has a vested or contingent interest in any personal chattels to have the use and enjoyment of the chattels in such manner and subject to such conditions (if any) as the administrator may consider reasonable, and without being liable to account for any consequential loss.
(2) If the trusts in favour of the issue of the intestate fail by reason of no
child or other issue attaining an absolutely vested interest –
(a) The estate of the intestate and the income of it and all statutory
accumulations, if any, of the income, or so much of it as may not
have been paid or applied under any power affecting the same,
shall go, devolve, and be held under this Act as if the intestate had
died without leaving issue living at the death of the intestate;
(b) References in this Act to the intestate “leaving no issue” shall, subject
to this section, be construed as “leaving no issue who attain an
absolutely vested interest”;
(c) References in this Act to the intestate “leaving issue” or “leaving a
child or other issue” shall, subject to this section, be construed as
“leaving issue who attain an absolutely vested interest”.
(3) Where under this Act the estate of an intestate or any part of it is directed
to be held on the statutory trusts for any class of the relatives of the intestate,
other than issue of the intestate, the same shall be held on trusts corresponding to
the statutory trusts for the issue of the intestate as if those trusts were repeated
with the substitution of references to the members or member of that class for
references to the children or child of the intestate.

79 Application to cases of partial intestacy

(1) Where any person dies leaving a will effectively disposing of part of
his estate this Part, shall have effect in respect of the part of his estate not so disposed of, subject to the will and subsection (2).
(2) Where the deceased leaves a husband or wife who acquires a beneficial interest under the will of the deceased, the references in section 77 to a sum of
$12,000 payable to a surviving husband or wife, and to interest on that sum, shall
be taken as references to that sum diminished by the value of the beneficial interest
at the date of death, and to interest on that sum as so diminished, and, accordingly,
where the value exceeds that sum, section 77 shall have effect as if references to
that sum and to interest were omitted.
(3) References in subsections (1) or (2) to a beneficial interest acquired under
a will shall be construed –
(a) As including a reference to a beneficial interest acquired by virtue
of the exercise by the will of a general power of appointment, but
not a special power of appointment;
(b) As not including a reference to a beneficial interest in any personal
chattels.
(4) For the purposes of this section the administrator may ascertain and
fix the value of the beneficial interest under section 28 of the Trustee Act 1956, and
no action shall lie against the administrator if he distributes the estate in accordance
with the value that he has honestly and reasonably so fixed.

Administration Act 1969 95

80 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

81 Right of successor on intestacy to disclaim

(1) Subject to this section, where a successor has become entitled under
this Act to an interest as a beneficiary in the whole or any part of the real and
personal property which passes on the intestacy of any person –
(a) The successor may, by deed delivered to the intestate person’s
administrator, disclaim that interest if at the date of the disclaimer
he has attained full age and is of sound mind;
(b) The Court may, by order, disclaim the interest on behalf of the
successor or authorise the disclaimer of the interest by or on behalf
of the successor if at the date of the disclaimer the successor has not
attained full age or is not of sound mind.
(2) No disclaimer under this section shall be valid unless –
(a) The disclaimer is made by the successor in his lifetime; and
(b) The disclaimer relates to the whole of the successor ’s interest as a
beneficiary in the real and personal property which passes on the
intestacy of the person, including property which any other person
has disclaimed under this section; and
(c) The disclaimer is made within one year after the date of the first
grant in Niue of administration in respect of the estate or will of the
intestate person or within such extended period as may be allowed
by the Court.
(3) No disclaimer under this section shall be valid if –
(a) The successor has entered into enjoyment of the whole or any part
of the interest to which he has become entitled as aforesaid; or
(b) The successor has transferred, assigned, mortgaged, settled, or
otherwise disposed of that interest or of any part of it or of any
property which would include that interest or any part of it if it
were not disclaimed, or has covenanted or agreed to do any such
thing; or
(c) There is any valuable consideration for the disclaimer; or
(d) The disclaimer provides for any assignment of the disclaimed
interest or in any manner provides who is to be entitled to that
interest; or
(e) The successor is bankrupt when the disclaimer is made.
(4) Every disclaimer under this section shall be irrevocable.
(5) Where a disclaimer which complies with all the requirements of this
section has been made by or on behalf of any successor and the disclaimer is not
void and does not become void by reason of its being deemed under section 82 to
be a transfer of the disclaimed interest –
(a) The property which passes on the intestacy of the person shall be
distributed, and estate duty in his estate shall be assessed, as if the
successor had died immediately before the intestate person leaving
only such issue (if any) as the successor would have left if he had
died immediately before the intestate person;
(b) The successor shall be deemed for all purposes neither to have
become entitled to nor to have disposed of the disclaimed interest
or any part of it.
96 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(6) Nothing in this section shall affect any right which any successor may have to disclaim any property apart from this section.
(7) Every disclaimer under this section shall be deemed to be made at the first point of time when everything has been done in respect of the disclaimer which is necessary to comply with the requirements of this section and of any order of the Court which relates to the disclaimer and is made under this section.

82 Effect of bankruptcy on disclaimer

(1) Where a successor disclaims the interest as a beneficiary to which he is
entitled in any real or personal property which passes on the intestacy of any
person, or disclaims any interest as a beneficiary in any real or personal property
to which he is entitled under the will of a deceased person, then, for the purposes
of any rule of law relating to the protection of creditors –
(a) The successor shall be deemed to have accepted the disclaimed
interest; and
(b) The disclaimer shall be deemed to be a transfer of the disclaimed
interest by the successor to the person or persons who become
entitled to it in consequence of the disclaimer.
(2) Where any such successor has disclaimed any such interest in any
property and there is no possibility of the disclaimer being void or voidable
otherwise than by reason of its being deemed to be a transfer of the disclaimed
interest, the deceased person’s administrator may distribute the disclaimed interest
or any part of it as if there were no possibility of the disclaimer being or becoming
void or voidable by reason of its being deemed to be a transfer of the disclaimed
interest if, at the date of the distribution –
(a) The successor is not bankrupt; and
(b) The administrator has no reason to believe that the successor is
about to become bankrupt; and
(c) The administrator has no reason to believe that the disclaimer is
void or voidable or is about to become void or voidable by reason
of its being deemed to be a transfer of the disclaimed interest.
(3) No action shall lie against any such administrator by reason of his
distributing any disclaimed interest as aforesaid or by reason of his having failed
to make any inquiry as to whether the successor was about to become bankrupt
or as to whether the disclaimer was void or voidable or about to become void or
voidable by reason of its being deemed to be a transfer of the disclaimed interest;
but nothing in this subsection or in subsection (2) shall affect any right which any
person may have to follow and recover any property to which the disclaimer relates.

83 [Spent]

84 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Administration Act 1969 97

SCHEDULE Section 18

Certificate of Administration

In the High Court of Niue

In the estate of , of

Under section 18 of the Administration Act 1969, I hereby certify that, on the

day of 20 , probate of the will [or letters of

administration in the estate]* of the above-named deceased who died on or

Registrar.

*In the case of a limited or special grant the exact nature of the grant should be shown.

98 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

99

ADOPTION ACT 1955

1955/93 – 27 October 1955

1 This is the Adoption Act 1955.

2-15 –

16 Effect of adoption order

(1) Every adoption order shall confer the surname of the adoptive parent
on the adopted child, with such first or Christian name as the Court, on the
application of the person who is applying for the adoption order, may fix.
(2) Upon an adoption order being made, the following shall have effect for
all purposes, whether civil, criminal, or otherwise, but subject to the provisions of
any enactment which distinguishes in any way between adopted children and
children other than adopted children, namely –
(a) The adopted child shall be deemed to be the child of the adoptive
parent, and the adoptive parent shall be deemed to be the parent of
the child, as if the child had been born to that parent in lawful
wedlock:
Provided that, where the adopted child is adopted by his mother
either alone or jointly with her husband, the making of the adoption
order shall not prevent the making of an affiliation order or
maintenance order, or of an application for an affiliation order or
maintenance order, in respect of the child;
(b) The adopted child shall be deemed to cease to be the child of his
existing parents (whether his natural parents or his adoptive parents
under any previous adoption), and the existing parents of the
adopted child shall be deemed to cease to be his parents, and any
existing adoption order in respect of the child shall be deemed to
be discharged under section 20:
Provided that, where the existing parents are the natural parents, this
paragraph shall not apply for the purposes of any enactment relating to forbidden
marriages or to the crime of incest;
(c) The relationship to one another of all persons (whether the adopted
child, the adoptive parent, the existing parents, or any other persons)
shall be determined under this subsection so far as they are
applicable;
(d) The foregoing provisions shall not apply for the purposes of any
deed, instrument, will, or intestacy, or affect any vested or contingent
right of the adopted child or any other person under any deed,
instrument, will, or intestacy, where the adoption order is made
after the date of the deed or instrument or after the date of the death
of the testator or intestate, as the case may be, unless in the case of
a deed, instrument, or will, express provision is made to that effect;
100 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(e) The adoption order shall not affect the race, nationality, or citizenship of the adopted child;
(f) The adopted child shall acquire the domicile of his adoptive parent or adoptive parents, and the child’s domicile shall thereafter be determined as if the child had been born in lawful wedlock to the said parent or parents:
Provided that nothing in this paragraph shall affect the domicile of origin of the child;
(g) In any case where the adoption order was made before the adopted
child attained the age of 3 years, the child’s domicile of origin shall
be deemed to be the domicile which he first acquired under
paragraph (f) upon the making of the adoption order, but nothing
in this Act shall affect the domicile of origin of an adopted child in
any other case;
(h) Any existing appointment as guardian of the adopted child shall
cease to have effect;
(i) Any affiliation order or maintenance order in respect of the adopted
child and any agreement (not being in the nature of a trust) which
provides for payments for the maintenance of the adopted child
shall cease to have effect:
Provided that, where the adopted child is adopted by his mother either
alone or jointly with her husband, the order or agreement shall not cease to have
effect by reason of the making of the adoption order:
Provided also that nothing shall prevent the recovery of any arrears which
are due under any order or agreement at the date on which it ceases to have
effect.

17-19 –

20 Adoption order discharged

Upon an adoption order being discharged –
(a) The relationship to one another of all persons (whether the adopted
child, the adoptive parents, the natural parents, the guardians of
the child at the date of the adoption order or adoption, or any other
persons) shall be determined as if the adoption order or adoption
had not been made; and any appointment as guardian of the
adopted child which was made while the adoption order or
adoption was in force shall cease to have effect:
Provided that the discharge of the order or adoption shall not affect
anything lawfully done or the consequences of anything unlawfully
done while the order or adoption was in force;
(b) No change in the child’s domicile shall occur by reason only of the
discharge; but, where during the infancy of the child any natural
parent resumes custody of the child to whom the discharged order
or adoption related, the domicile of the child shall be determined
as if neither the discharged order or adoption nor any prior adoption
order or adoption in respect of the child had been made;
(c) Any affiliation order, maintenance order, or agreement for payment
of maintenance which ceased to have effect under section 16 (2) (i)
have effect under its terms:
Provided that nothing in this paragraph shall cause the order or
agreement to have any effect in respect of the period while the
adoption order or adoption remained in force:

Adoption Act 1955

101
Provided also that notice of the discharge of the adoption order or adoption shall be served on every person who is bound by the affiliation order, maintenance order, or agreement, but nothing in this proviso shall restrict the effect of the affiliation order, maintenance order, or agreement between the date of the discharge of the adoption order or adoption and the service of notice of the discharge;
(d) For the purposes of any other deed or instrument (except a will) made while the order or adoption was in force, or of the will or intestacy of any testator or intestate who died while the order or adoption was in force, or of any vested or contingent right of the adopted child or any other person under any such deed, instrument, will or intestacy, the order or adoption shall be deemed to continue in force.

102 Niue wws 2006 Vol 1

103

AGRICULTURE QUARANTINE ACT 1984

1984/99 – 12 February 1985

1 Short title 16 Control of arrivals from overseas

2 Interpretation 17 Duty of Officers

3 Act to bind Crown

PART 3

PART 1 DISEASE CONTROL

ADMINISTRATION 17A Duty to notify disease

4 Appointment of Quarantine Officers 17B Power to declare Infected Place

5 Powers of Quarantine Officers 17C Disease Control Area

6 Rights of entry 17D Powers of Director to destroy

7 Liability for Crown expense 18 Emergency powers

8 Obstructing or hindering Quarantine 19 Diseases and pests in crops for export

Officer

9 Protection of Quarantine Officer PART 4

REGULATIONS

PART 2 20 Regulations

IMPORTATION

10 Quarantine Stations PART 5

11 Restrictions on importation MISCELLANEOUS

12 Importations for research 21 Dispatch of animal or plant material to

13 Seizure and disposal Niue

14 Duty to prevent material being landed 22 False declarations and documents

15 Material illegally introduced may be 23 Offences

seized

24–25 [Spent]

To make provision for the protection of plants and animals

1 Short title

This is the Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“animal” means any living or dead stage of any member of the animal
kingdom and includes the egg or semen or larva or embryo or the
carcase of or tissue derived from an animal;
“animal product” means any part of an animal and any product that is
wholly or partly derived from an animal or any part of an animal, being
a part of an animal or a product that has not been treated or sterilised
to the stage where it is rendered free from any viable form of any
organism capable of causing disease;
104 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“biological product” means any material, vaccine, chemical, hormone, enzyme, tissue or other thing derived from any animal, plant or organism;
“conveyance” means any kind of vehicle which may travel by land, sea or air and includes a cargo container;
“declaration” means a written statement concerning any animal, animal
product, plant or plant material or any other goods restricted or
prohibited under this Act;
“Director” means the Director of Agriculture and includes the Deputy;
“disease” means any unhealthy condition in any animal or plant suspected
of being caused by an organism, and includes diseases transmissible
from animals to man;
“diseased” means affected or has been affected by any disease, or as a result
of diagnostic test or tests, is judged to have been affected by any disease
or exposed to the causal agent of any disease; and in relation to any
animal product or plant material that it has been derived from a diseased
animal or plant;
“goods” means any movable property involving a quarantine hazard;
“import” means to introduce into Niue from any place outside of Niue
whether by sea or air;
“infected” in relation to any animal or animal product or plant material
means that it has been in direct or indirect contact with a diseased animal
or plant or any place or vicinity or goods or thing which is suspected to
be carrying or harbouring a disease or pest;
“land” includes any area, field, farm, garden, orchard, nursery, hothouse,
shadehouse, cool store, dwellinghouse, shop, building, room or other
place or premises and references to land extend to and include any
harbour, highway, road, wharf, port or airport;
“organism” means any micro-organism, virus, bacterium, fungus,
protozoon, parasite or other organism; and includes any dead,
inactivated attenuated or genetically modified form of any such micro­
organism, bacterium, fungus, protozoon, parasite or other organism;
“Quarantine Officer” means any officer appointed under section 4 and
includes an assistant;
“quarantine station” means any area established by section 10(1);
“packing material” includes items not necessarily of animal or plant origin
but which have been enclosed with the consignment during transport;
“permit” means a document issued by the Director indicating the conditions
under which animals, animal products, plant, plant material and goods
may be imported;
“pest” means any organism pestilent to animals or plants, and includes
weed pests and insect pests;
“plant” means all species, varieties and types of vegetation or parts of them
whether living or not and includes stems, branches, tubers, bulbs,
culture, corms, stocks, budwood, cuttings, layers, slips, suckers, roots,
leaves, flowers, fruit, seeds and any other plant growth and includes a
dead plant;
“plant material” includes any fruit, seed, spore and portion or product of
any plant unless, by any manufacturing process, it has been rendered
free from all diseases and pests and has been made incapable of carrying
any disease or pest;

Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984

105
“port” includes seaport, airport and post office;
“refuse” means any garbage or waste material, rubbish or packing whether
or not of animal or plant origin;
“soil” includes earth, water, peat, compost, sand, clay and any other
substance capable of supporting plant life or transmitting disease or
pest whether or not used or intended to be used as a growing medium
or in any process of manufacture, or as a ballast or for any purpose
whatsoever;
“treatment” means any form of operation including disinfection and
disinfestation to ensure removal sterilisation or killing of any animal
or plant, pest or disease by such means as are deemed most appropriate
and includes destruction.

3 Act to bind Crown

This Act binds the Government.
PART 1
ADMINISTRATION

4 Appointment of Quarantine Officers

There shall be appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission such
Quarantine Officers as may be necessary for the purposes of this Act.

5 Powers of Quarantine Officers

(1) Every Quarantine Officer may for the purposes of this Act detain, open,
inspect, examine, sample, submit for diagnostic examination, direct reshipment,
direct removal to a quarantine area, remove for treatment, treat any animal, animal
product, plant material, beneficial organism, disease, pest, soil, package, packing
material, article of luggage or other thing.
(2) No Quarantine Officer shall direct reshipment or destroy or otherwise
dispose of anything under this section unless with the concurrence of the Director
and that the owner or the importer is invited to witness destruction.

6 Rights of entry

Every Quarantine Officer may, for the purposes of this Act and on producing
(if so required) due evidence of his appointment, enter at any time upon any land
dwelling or into any conveyance.

7 Liability for Crown expense

If any person by failing to comply with or acting contrary to this Act, causes
a Quarantine Officer or an employee in the Public Service to incur an expense that
he would not otherwise have incurred, that person shall reimburse the Government
for the full amount of that expense reasonably and properly incurred and that
amount shall be recoverable from that person as a debt due to the Crown.

8 Obstructing or hindering Quarantine Officer

Every person commits an offence who directly or indirectly obstructs,
hinders, interrupts, threatens, or assaults any Quarantine Officer or any assistant
of a Quarantine Officer in the performance of his duty under this Act.

9 Protection of Quarantine Officer

A Quarantine Officer shall not be liable for any loss or damage resulting
from the exercise of powers conferred by this Act unless the loss or damage is
caused otherwise than in the reasonable exercise of those powers.
106 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

10 Quarantine Stations

PART 2
IMPORTATION
(1) The Cabinet may at any port or place in Niue by notice in the Gazette set apart and define any land under its control as a quarantine station for the detention or treatment of animals, animal products, plants or plant material and may vary, alter, redefine or abolish any such quarantine station.
(2) The Director may from time to time give directions on the regulation management and control of quarantine stations and the disposal treatment or destruction of animals, animal products, plants or plant material while in the quarantine station; and may by any such direction specify any treatment that can also include the time during which any animal, animal product, plant or plant material intended to be introduced into Niue shall remain in a quarantine station.

11 Restrictions on importation

(1) No person shall import or introduce any animal, animal product, plant,
plant material or organism or biological product or goods or packing material,
into Niue –
(a) Without the written permit of the Director; or
(b) In contravention of any regulations made under this Act.
(2) Every such permit shall be subject to such conditions as may be specified
in the permit and in any regulations made under this Act.
(3) Any such permit may be revoked or varied at any time by the Director.

12 Importation for research

Notwithstanding anything in this Act, the Director may, for the purpose of
scientific research or experiment and subject to such terms and conditions as he
thinks fit, permit the importation into Niue of any animal, animal product, plant
or plant material or organism or biological product or goods not otherwise eligible
for importation into Niue.

13 Seizure and disposal

Where any animal, animal product, plant or plant material or organism or
biological product is found by a Quarantine Officer on any conveyance and the
animal, animal product, plant or plant material or organism or biological product
is not being imported or introduced into Niue under this Act the animal, animal
product, plant or plant material or organism or biological product, shall be deemed
to be smuggled; and unless the Director directs that it be retained on the ship or
aircraft and reshipped therewith, the animal, animal product, plant or plant
material or organism or biological product shall be seized and destroyed and no
compensation shall be payable in respect of it.

14 Duty to prevent materials being landed

The owner, charterer, agent, master or captain of any conveyance arriving
in Niue shall –
(a) Prevent any animal, animal product, plant or plant material or
organism or biological product from being landed from that
conveyance unless permitted by the Director; and
(b) If so required by the Director enter into a bond for such amount not
exceeding $1,000 as the Quarantine Officer may require to secure
due compliance with this section.

Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984

107

15 Material illegally introduced may be seized

Any animal, animal product, plant or plant material or organism or
biological product or goods introduced into Niue contrary to this Act, may, together
with anything else that may have been in contact, be seized by a Quarantine Officer
and may be treated as the Director thinks fit.

16 Control of arrivals from overseas

(1) No person arriving in Niue by any conveyance from any country shall
leave that conveyance or any wharf or airport to which that conveyance may come
without first completing a baggage declaration form regarding any animal, animal
product, plant or plant material or organism or biological product or goods which
he wishes to bring into Niue.
(2) No person shall remove or cause to be removed from any conveyance
arriving in Niue from any country, or from any wharf or airport to which that
conveyance may come, any animal , animal products, plant, plant material, or
organism or biological product or goods without the permission of a Quarantine
Officer.

17 Duty of Officers

It shall be the duty of all officers of the Post Office and of the Customs
respectively to assist in carrying out the provisions of section 15 and to prevent
the introduction into Niue of anything contrary to this Act, and for that purpose
they may, in respect of anything so introduced or attempted to be introduced or
brought, exercise all the powers confirmed by the Communications Act 1989 in
the case of postal articles posted in breach of that Act, and by the Customs Act
1966 in the cause of uncustomed or prohibited goods.

17A Duty to notify disease

PART 3
DISEASE CONTROL
It shall be the duty of any owner or person in charge of any animal or plant to notify as soon as practicable a Quarantine Officer, Livestock Officer, or other competent person if he suspects the presence of disease or pests in the animal or plant and if so directed, to hold for examination the carcase of any animal which has died.

17B Power to declare Infected Place

(1) A Quarantine Officer, Livestock Officer or other authorised person may,
if he suspects that any animal or plant is diseased or infected, declare the land or
premises on which the animal or plant is kept and any other land in the
neighbourhood which may be specified to be an Infected Place.
(2) Whilst the declaration of an infected place is in effect, no animal or
plant may be introduced and no animal, animal product, animal manure, plant,
plant material, fitting, fodder, goods or thing may be removed from that Infected
Place except by permission of a Quarantine Officer, Livestock Officer or other
authorised person and under such conditions as may be specified.
(3) Any declaration of an infected place may be revoked at any time by a
Quarantine Officer, Livestock Officer or other authorised person; and the force of
any such declaration shall in any case, unless sooner renewed lapse 3 months
after the date of that declaration.
108 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

17C Disease Control Area

(1) Whilst an infected place continues to exist the Director may designate
an area around and including the infected place or the whole of Niue, to be a
Disease Control Area.
(2) Whilst a Disease Control Area is in effect, the Director may by public
notice or radio or television announcement direct that, subject to such conditions
he may impose or exemptions he may give, no animal, animal product, animal
excreta, plant, plant material, fodder, fittings, goods or other things as may be
specified may be moved out of, or into, or within the Disease Control Area without
the permission of a Quarantine Officer, Livestock Officer or other authorised
person.

17D Powers of Director to destroy

The Director may, with the approval of the Minister of Agriculture cause
steps to be taken to destroy any diseased or infected animals or plants or animals
or plants suspected of being diseased or infected, for the purposes of eradicating
or controlling a disease, or preventing its spread.

18 Emergency powers

(1) Cabinet may declare by proclamation that a state of agriculture
emergency exists throughout all or any part or parts of Niue under the Public
Emergency Act 1979, and while that state of emergency continues Cabinet may
direct that such measures be taken as it or any person authorised by Cabinet may
specify as necessary for the purpose of preventing the establishment of the serious
disease or pest in Niue or any part of Niue or eradicating it from Niue or any part
of Niue.
(2) The Cabinet may pay to the owner of any animal, animal product, plant
or plant material or any other goods destroyed as an emergency measure an amount
by way of compensation equal to the fair market value of it, fixed as at the time of
the inspection that results in the destruction of the animal, animal product, plant,
plant material or other goods, such compensation shall be ascertained by arbitration
under the Arbitration Act 1908.

19 Diseases and pests in crops for export

(1) If the Quarantine Officer has reason to believe that any disease or pest
is present or which contravenes the regulations of the importing country in any
animal, animal product, plant, plant material or goods which a person intends to
export he may by notice in writing direct that person not to export all or such
portion of the animal, animal product, plant or plant material or such portion of
the goods as the Quarantine Officer may decide.
(2) Any person who contrary to any such notice exports any animal, animal
product, plant, plant material or goods commits an offence.

20 Regulations

PART 4
REGULATIONS
The Cabinet may make regulations for the purpose of carrying out this Act and without in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing –
(a) Providing for the treatment or seizure and destruction of any animal, animal products, plants, plant material or goods that are diseased or infected or suspected of being diseased or infected;

Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984

109
(b) Prescribing the powers and duties of Quarantine Officers;
(c) Providing for the eradication and prevention of the spread of any
disease or pests;
(d) Prohibiting the introduction into Niue either generally or from any
specified region, country, or place of origin of all animals, animal
products, plants or plant material or organism or biological product
or such of the above as may be named or identified as being likely
to introduce any disease or pest into Niue;
(e) Prohibiting or restricting the introduction into Niue of any disease
or pest or organism or biological product;
(f) Prescribing conditions for introducing any animal, animal product,
plant or plant material or organism or biological product or goods
into Niue either generally or from any specified region, country or
place of origin;
(g) Prescribing the matters for which fees shall be payable under this
Act, fixing the amount of those fees and the mode of their payment
and recovery;
(h) Providing for such matters as are contemplated by or are necessary
to give full effect to this Act and for its due administration.
PART 5
MISCELLANEOUS

21 Dispatch of animal or plant material to Niue

(1) No person shall be deemed to have introduced into Niue any animal,
animal product, plant or plant material received by that person from overseas
without his consent given before dispatch of the animal, animal product, plant or
plant material to Niue.
(2) Notwithstanding that any person receives such animal, animal product,
plant or plant material from overseas without his consent given before dispatch
of the material, he shall on receipt of the animal, animal product, plant or plant
material immediately notify a Quarantine Officer and carry out to the satisfaction
of the Quarantine Officer such directions as the Quarantine Officer may give as to
the treatment of the animal, animal product, plant or plant material.

22 False declarations and documents

Every person who makes any false declaration or tenders any false
document under this Act knowing the declaration or document to be false commits
an offence.

23 Offences

(1) Every person who fails to comply with or act in contravention of this
Act or any Regulations made under it or any order, direction, requirement, or
condition made, given, or imposed by the Director or Quarantine Officer under
any powers conferred by or under this Act or any Regulations commits an offence.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this Act is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 20 penalty units, or imprisonment of not more
than 12 months.

24–25 [Spent]

110 Niue Laws 2006 Vall

111

APPROPRIATION (ANNUAL) ACT 2006

2006/277 – 1 July 2006

1 Short title 2 Grant and appropriation

To appropriate certain sums of money out of the Niue Assembly Account to the services for the year ending 30 June 2007 and to appropriate the supplies granted in that year

1 Short title

(1) This is the Appropriation (Annual) Act 2006.
(2) This Act shall relate to the financial year ending on 30 June 2007 (the
“financial year”).

2 Grant and appropriation

(1) There may be issued and supplied from the Niue Assembly Account
towards making good the supplies granted to Her Majesty for the services of the
financial year, for Recurrent Expenditure, Capital Projects, Corporations and
Special Projects a sum which does not exceed $23,414,292 in total.
(2) The particulars of which are set out under the relevant headings in the
Schedules.
112 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Appropriation from the Niue Assembly Account for RECURRENT, CAPITAL, and CORPORATIONS for the Financial Year ending 30 June 2007

NON TRADING DEPARTMENTS Administration Services Agriculture

Community Affairs Education Environment Health

Justice

Public Service Commission

Police

Public Works

Premiers

Taoga Niue

Treasury

Meteorological

TRADING OPERATIONS Administration: Govt Residences Public Works: All Trading Treasury: Bondstore

Telecom & Postal

Niue Power

Bulk Fuel

Tourism Authority

CORPORATIONS Broadcasting

NDB

SPECIAL PROJECTS Cyclone Heta

NZAID

Donor Repayment

CAPITAL PROJECTS Education

TOTAL 20,005,202 50,000 238,556 3,120,534 23,414,292

––––––––– ––––––––– ––––––––– ––––––––– –––––––––

Appropriation (Annual) Act 2006

ANNUAL ESTIMATES NIUE GOVERNMENT 2006/2007

STATEMENT OF ESTIMATED SOURCE & APPLICATION OF FUNDS

113

SOURCE OF FUNDS Taxation Income

Import Duty Company Other

Total Taxation

Other Interest on Investments

Fishing Rights

Other Government Receipts

Total Other Revenue

Total Department Revenue Trading Operations Corporations

Special Projects

Total Recurrent Revenue

TOTAL INTERNAL FUNDING NZ Funding – Recurrent

TOTAL NZ FUNDING

TOTAL FUNDING REVENUE

APPLICATION OF FUNDS Departmental – Recurrent Trading Operations Corporations

Special Projects

Total Recurrent Application

Capital Projects

Total Capital Disbursement

TOTAL EXPENDITURE RECURRENT SURPLUS/(DEFICIT)

2006/2007

ESTIMATES

1,969,644

1,033,500

55,000

236,800

––––––––

3,294,944

––––––––

10,000

382,775

1,259,053

––––––––

1,651,828

––––––––

4,946,772

8,571,986

110,000

2,870,534

–––––––––

16,499,292

–––––––––

16,499,292

6,915,000

6,915,000

–––––––––

23,414,292

–––––––––

11,277,032

8,728,170

238,556

3,120,534

–––––––––

23,364,292

–––––––––

50,000

–––––––––

50,000

–––––––––

23,414,292

–––––––––

(0)

–––––––––

2005/2006 June

VOTED Prov

1,844,442 1,846,818

948,500 934,801

50,000 3,362

198,800 229,193

–––––––– ––––––––

3,041,742 3,014,174

–––––––– ––––––––

2,000 31,084

262,775 243,067

1,116,715 845,333

–––––––– ––––––––

1,381,490 1,119,484

–––––––– ––––––––

4,423,232 4,133,658

6,630,642 7,003,727

80,000 50,267

3,611,631 3,018,561

––––––––– –––––––––

14,745,505 14,206,212

––––––––– –––––––––

14,745,505 14,206,212

6,952,500 6,952,500

6,952,500 6,952,500

––––––––– –––––––––

21,698,005 21,158,712

––––––––– –––––––––

10,978,294 11,163,781

6,722,931 7,536,347

285,149 232,617

3,611,631 2,484,581

––––––––– –––––––––

21,598,005 21,417,325

––––––––– –––––––––

100,000 89,733

––––––––– –––––––––

100,000 89,733

––––––––– –––––––––

21,698,005 21,507,059

––––––––– –––––––––

(0) (348,346)

––––––––– –––––––––

114 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

SUMMARY OF REVENUE FOR YEAR ENDING 30 JUNE 2007

2006/2007 2005/2006 June

DEPARTMENT

NON-TRADING Administrative Services Agriculture

Community Affairs

Education

Health

Justice

Police

Public Works

Premiers

Taoga Niue

Treasury

Meteorological

TOTAL NON-TRADING

TRADING OPERATIONS Admin: Govt Residences Public Works Trading Treasury: Bond Store Telecom & Postal

Niue Power

Bulk Fuel

TOTAL TRADING

CORPORATIONS Broadcasting

TOTAL CORPORATIONS

SPECIAL PROJECTS Cyclone Heta

NZ AID

TOTAL SPECIAL PROJECTS TOTAL INTERNAL FUNDING

NZ FUNDING Recurrent

TOTAL NZ FUNDING TOTAL REVENUE

ESTIMATE

21,000

416,822

600

83,250

152,500

25,000

92,425

185,800

241,000

10,500

3,717,475

400

–––––––––

4,946,772

–––––––––

101,761

361,000

956,600

1,288,150

1,238,655

4,625,820

–––––––––

8,571,986

–––––––––

110,000

–––––––––

110,000

–––––––––

995,534

1,875,000

–––––––––

2,870,534

–––––––––

16,499,292

–––––––––

6,915,000

–––––––––

6,915,000

–––––––––

23,414,292

–––––––––

VOTED Prov

18,350 16,400

266,190 256,938

0 0

500 655

9,500 8,126

22,500 28,353

57,925 92,153

208,242 157,031

252,512 303,515

0 0

3,587,113 3,266,215

400 4,272

––––––––– –––––––––

4,423,232 4,133,658

––––––––– –––––––––

106,960 85,126

218,000 166,622

794,000 802,636

1,202,750 1,150,686

1,286,932 1,199,616

3,022,000 3,599,041

––––––––– –––––––––

6,630,642 7,003,727

––––––––– –––––––––

80,000 50,267

––––––––– –––––––––

80,000 50,267

––––––––– –––––––––

1,826,430 1,746,022

1,785,201 1,272,539

––––––––– –––––––––

3,611,631 3,018,561

––––––––– –––––––––

14,745,505 14,206,212

––––––––– –––––––––

6,952,500 6,952,500

––––––––– –––––––––

6,952,500 6,952,500

––––––––– –––––––––

21,698,005 21,158,712

––––––––– –––––––––

Appropriation (Annual) Act 2006

GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

SUMMARY OF EXPENDITURE FOR YEAR ENDING 30 JUNE 2007

115

2006/2007 2005/2006 June

DEPARTMENT

ESTIMATE

VOTED Prov

NON-TRADING

Administrative Services

668,030

726,200 780,155

Agriculture

557,834

508,612 531,851

Community Affairs

1,964,425

1,855,047 1,921,154

Education

1,350,650

1,486,286 1,544,651

Environment

126,900

99,011 99,802

Health

1,500,090

1,326,375 1,465,285

Justice

394,922

391,154 352,250

Public Service Commission

319,877

338,224 296,653

Police

416,278

344,392 355,646

Public Works

706,294

846,864 861,697

Premiers

2,570,105

2,324,815 2,328,138

Taoga Niue

113,423

0 0

Treasury

505,303

648,155 556,003

Meteorological

82,901

83,159 70,495

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

TOTAL NON TRADING

11,277,032

10,978,294 11,163,781

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

TRADING OPERATIONS

Admin: Gov Residences

27,842

55,149 64,208

Public Works: All Trading

574,790

503,587 548,253

Treasury: Bond Store

673,438

650,463 719,766

Telecom & Postal Corporation

1,288,150

1,202,750 917,696

Niue Power

1,522,807

1,353,396 1,476,648

Bulk Fuel

4,492,949

2,747,571 3,592,146

Tourism Authority

148,194

210,016 217,630

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

TOTAL TRADING

8,728,170

6,722,931 7,536,347

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

CORPORATIONS

Broadcasting

238,556

275,149 222,617

Niue Development Bank

0

10,000 10,000

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

TOTAL CORPORATIONS

238,556

285,149 232,617

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

SPECIAL PROJECTS

Cyclone Heta

995,534

1,826,430 1,012,746

Donor Projects

530,000

0 0

NZ AID

1,595,000

1,785,201 1,471,835

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

TOTAL SPECIAL PROJECTS

3,120,534

3,611,631 2,484,581

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

RECURRENT EXPENDITURE

23,364,292

21,598,005 21,417,325

CAPITAL

Taoga Niue Office

0

100,000 89,733

Capital Projects

50,000

0 0

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

CAPITAL EXPENDITURE

50,000

100,000 89,733

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

TOTAL EXPENDITURE

23,414,292

21,698,005 21,507,059

–––––––––

––––––––– –––––––––

116 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

SUMMARIES OF BUDGET PROPOSALS FOR YEAR ENDING 30 JUNE 2007

REVENUE LESS EXPENDITURE

2006/2007 2005/2006 June

DEPARTMENT ESTIMATE VOTED Prov

TOTAL REVENUE 23,414,292 21,698,005 21,158,712

TOTAL EXPENDITURE 23,414,292 21,698,005 21,507,059

––––––––– ––––––––– –––––––––

SURPLUS/(DEFICIT) (0) (0) (348,346)

––––––––– ––––––––– –––––––––

117

ARBITRATION ACT 1908

1908/8 (NZ) – 4 August 1908

1

Short title

15

Power to refer in certain cases

2

Interpretation

16

Powers and remuneration of arbitrators

17

Court to have powers as in references by

References by Consent out of Court

consent

3

Submission to be irrevocable

18

Court of Appeal to have powers of Court

4

Provisions implied in submissions

5

Power of Court to stay proceedings where

General

there is a submission

19

Power to compel attendance of witness in

6

Appointment of arbitrator or umpire

any part of Niue, and to order prisoner to

7

Power for parties to supply vacancy

attend

8

Powers of arbitrator

20

[Repealed]

9

Witnesses may be subpoenaed

21

Costs

10

Power to enlarge time for making award

22

Arbitrator

or

umpire

entitled

to

11

Power to remit award

remuneration

12

Power to remove arbitrator or set aside

23

Power to make rules

award

24

Act binds the Government

13

Enforcing award

25

Application of Act to references under

statutory powers

References Under Order of Court

14

Reference for report

SCHEDULES

To consolidate certain enactments relating to arbitration

1 Short title

This is the Arbitration Act 1908.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“arbitrator” includes referee and valuer;
“Court” means the High Court, and includes a Judge of it;
“rules of Court” means rules of the Court of Appeal, or of the High Court,
made by the proper authority under this Act;
“submission” means a written agreement to submit present or future
differences to arbitration, whether an arbitrator is named in it or not,
or under which any question or matter is to be decided by one or more
persons to be appointed by the contracting parties or by some person
named in the agreement.
118 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

References by Consent out of Court

3 Submission to be irrevocable

A submission, unless a contrary intention is expressed in it, shall be
irrevocable, except by leave of the Court and shall have the same effect in all
respects as if made an order of Court.

4 Provisions implied in submissions

A submission, unless a contrary intention is expressed in it, shall be deemed
to include the provisions in Schedule 2 so far as they are applicable to the reference
under the submission.

5 Power of Court to stay proceedings where there is a submission

If any party to a submission or any person claiming through or under him,
commences any legal proceedings in any Court against any other party to the
submission, or any person claiming through or under him, in respect of any matter
agreed to be referred, any party to those legal proceedings may, at any time before
filing a statement of defence or a notice of intention to defend or taking any other
step in the proceedings, apply to the Court in which the proceedings were
commenced to stay the proceedings; and that Court may, if satisfied that there is
no sufficient reason why the matter should not be referred under the submission,
and that the applicant was at the time when the proceedings were commenced,
and still remains, ready and willing to do all things necessary to the proper conduct
of the arbitration, make an order staying the proceedings.

6 Appointment of arbitrator or umpire

(1) In any of the following cases –
(a) Where a submission provides that the reference shall be to a single
arbitrator, and all the parties do not concur in the appointment of
an arbitrator; or
(b) Where an appointed arbitrator fails to act, or is or becomes incapable
of acting, or dies, and the submission does not show that it was
intended that the vacancy should not be supplied, and the parties
do not supply the vacancy; or
(c) Where the parties or 2 arbitrators are at liberty to appoint an umpire
or a third arbitrator or where 2 arbitrators are required to appoint
an umpire and do not appoint one; or
(d) Where an appointed umpire or third arbitrator fails to act, or is or
becomes incapable of acting, or dies, and the submission does not
show that it was intended that the vacancy should not be supplied,
and the parties or arbitrators do not supply the vacancy –
any party may serve the other party or the arbitrators, as the case may be, with a
written notice to appoint an arbitrator or umpire or a third arbitrator.
(2) If the appointment is not made within 7 days after the service of the
notice, the Court may, on application by the party who gave the notice, appoint
an arbitrator or umpire or a third arbitrator who shall have the like powers to act
in the reference and make an award as if he had been appointed by consent of all
parties.

7 Power for parties to supply vacancy

(1) Where a submission provides that the reference shall be to 2 arbitrators,
one to be appointed by each party, then, unless the submission expresses a contrary
intention –

Arbitration Act 1908

119
(a) If either of the appointed arbitrators fails to act, or is or becomes incapable of acting, or does, the party who appointed him may appoint a new arbitrator in his place; and
(b) If one party fails to appoint an arbitrator, either originally or by way of substitution as aforesaid, for 7 days after the other party, having appointed his arbitrator, has served the party making default with notice to make the appointment, the party who has appointed an arbitrator may appoint that arbitrator to act as sole arbitrator in the reference, and his award shall be binding on both parties as if he had been appointed by consent.
(2) The Court may set aside any appointment made in pursuance of this section.

8 Powers of arbitrator

The arbitrators or umpire acting under a submission may, unless the
submission expresses a contrary intention –
(a) Administer oaths to the parties and witnesses appearing; and
(b) [Repealed]
(c) Correct in any award any clerical mistake or error arising from any
accidental slip or omission.

9 Witnesses may be subpoenaed

Any party to a submission may sue out a write of subpoena ad testificandum,
or a writ of subpoena duces tecum, but no person shall be compelled under any such
writ to produce any document which he could not be compelled to produce on
the trial of an action.

10 Power to enlarge time for making award

The time for making an award may be enlarged by order of the Court,
whether the time for making the award has expired or not.

11 Power to remit award

(1) In all cases of reference to arbitration the Court may remit the matters
referred, or any of them, to the reconsideration of the arbitrators or umpire.
(2) Where an award is remitted the arbitrators or umpire shall, unless the
order otherwise directs, make their award within 3 months after the date of the
order.

12 Power to remove arbitrator or set aside award

(1) Where an arbitrator or umpire has misconducted himself or the
proceedings the Court may remove him.
(2) Where an arbitrator or umpire has misconducted himself or the
proceedings, or any arbitration or award has been improperly procured, the Court
may set the award aside.

13 Enforcing award

An award on a submission may, by leave of the Court, be enforced in the
same manner as a judgment or order to the same effect.
120 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

References under Order of Court

14 Reference for report

(1) Subject to rules of Court, the Court may refer any question arising in
any cause or matter (other than a criminal proceeding) for inquiry or report to an
official or special referee.
(2) The report of such official or special referee may be adopted wholly or
partially by the Court, and if so adopted may be enforced as a judgment or order
to the same effect.

15 Power to refer in certain cases

In any cause or matter (other than a criminal proceeding by the Crown) –
(a) If all the parties interested who are not under disability consent; or
(b) If the question in dispute consists wholly or in part of matters of
account; or
(c) If the cause of matter requires any prolonged examination of
documents, or any scientific or local investigation, which cannot in
the opinion of the Court conveniently be made before a jury or
conducted by the Court through its other ordinary officers –
the Court may at any time order the whole cause or matter or any question or
issue of fact arising therein, to be tried before an arbitrator agreed on by the parties,
or before an officer of the Court.

16 Powers and remuneration of arbitrators

(1) In all cases of reference to an arbitrator under an order of the Court in
any cause or matter the arbitrator shall be deemed to be an officer of the Court,
and shall have such authority, and shall conduct the reference in such manner, as
is prescribed by rules of Court, and subject to it, as the Court directs.
(2) The report or award of any arbitrator on any such reference shall, unless
set aside by the Court, be equivalent to the verdict of a jury.
(3) The remuneration to be paid to any arbitrator to whom any matter is
referred under order of the Court shall be determined by the Court.

17 Court to have powers as in references by consent

The Court shall, as to references under order of the Court, have all the
powers conferred by this Act on the Court as to references by consent out of Court.

18 Court of Appeal to have powers of Court

The Court of Appeal shall have all the powers conferred by this Act on the
Court under the provisions relating to references under order of the Court.

General

19 Power to compel attendance of witness in any part of Niue, and to order

prisoner to attend

(1) The Court may order that a writ of subpoena ad testificandum or of

subpoena duces tecum shall issue to compel the attendance before any arbitrator or

umpire of a witness wherever he may be in Niue.
(2) The Court may also, by order in writing under the hand of a Judge,
require a prisoner to be brought up for examination before any arbitrator or umpire,
and such order shall operate and be obeyed in like manner in all things as a writ of

habeas corpus ad testificandum issued out of the Court.

20 [Repealed]

Arbitration Act 1908

121

21 Costs

Any order may be made on such terms as to costs, or otherwise, as the
authority making the order thinks just.

22 Arbitrator or umpire entitled to remuneration

An arbitrator or umpire shall be entitled to a reasonable remuneration for
his services as such arbitrator or umpire, and if the parties to the submission do
not agree as to the amount to be paid, or as to the mode and time of payment, a
Judge may, on a summary application to him for that purpose, fix and determine
all or any of such matters.

23 Power to make rules

Rules may be made in the manner prescribed by section 70 of the Niue Act
1966 for the purpose of giving effect to this Act in the Court of Appeal or the High
Court.

24 Act binds the Government

This Act binds the Government of Niue but no arbitration involving the
Government shall proceed without the consent of Cabinet.

25 Application of Act to references under statutory powers

This Act applies to every arbitration under any Act passed before or after
the coming into operation of this Act as if the arbitration were under a submission,
except in so far as this Act is inconsistent with the Act regulating the arbitration,
or with any rules or procedure authorised or recognised by that Act.

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

[Spent]

SCHEDULE 2

Section 4

Provisions to be Implied in Submissions

1 If no other mode of reference is provided, the reference shall be to a single arbitrator.

2 If the reference is to 2 arbitrators, the 2 arbitrators shall appoint an umpire immediately after they are themselves appointed.

3 {Repealed 1938]

4 If the arbitrators have delivered to any party to the submission, or to the umpire, a notice in writing stating that they cannot agree, the umpire may forthwith enter on the reference in lieu of the arbitrators.

5 [Repealed]

122 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

6 The parties to the reference, and all persons claiming through them respectively, shall, subject to any legal objection, submit to be examined by the arbitrators or umpire on oath in relation to the matters in dispute, and shall, subject as aforesaid, produce before the arbitrators or umpire all books, deeds, papers, accounts, writings, or documents within their possession or power that may be required or called for, and do all such other things as during the proceedings on the reference the arbitrators or umpire may require.

7 The witnesses on the reference shall, if the arbitrators or umpire think fit, be examined on oath.

8 The award made by the arbitrators or umpire shall be final and binding on the parties and the persons claiming under them respectively.

9 The costs of the reference and award shall be in the discretion of the arbitrators or umpire, who may direct to and by whom and in what amount those costs or any part thereof shall be paid, and may tax or settle the amount of costs to be so paid or any part thereof, and may award costs to be paid as between solicitor and client.

10 The arbitrators or umpire shall have the same power as the Court to order specific performance of any contract other than a contract relating to land or interest in land.

11 The arbitrators or umpire may make an interim award.

123

ARBITRATION AMENDMENT ACT 1938

1938/6 (NZ) – 1 January 1939

1 Short title 11

2 Interpretation 12

3 Submission not to be discharged by death 13

of party 14

4 [Repealed] 15

5 Power of Court where arbitrator is 16

removed or appointment of arbitrator is

revoked

6 Appointment of three arbitrators 17

7 Provisions relating to umpires 18

8 Arbitrators and umpires to use due

Statement of case by arbitrator or umpire Entry of judgment in terms of award Interest on awards

Provision as to costs

Taxation of arbitrator ’s or umpire’s fees

Power of Court to give relief where

arbitrator is not impartial or dispute

referred involves question of fraud

[Spent]

Limitation of time for commencing

arbitration proceedings

dispatch 19-21 [Repealed]

9 [Spent]

10 Additional powers of Court SCHEDULE

To amend the Arbitration Act 1908

1 Short title

This is the Arbitration Amendment Act 1938, and shall be read together
with and deemed part of the Arbitration Act 1908 (the principal Act).

2 Interpretation

References in this Act and in the principal Act to an award shall be deemed
to include references to an interim award.

3 Submission not to be discharged by death of party

(1) A submission shall not be discharged by the death of any party to it,
either as respects the deceased or any other party, but shall in such an event be
enforceable by or against the personal representative of the deceased.
(2) The authority of an arbitrator shall not be revoked by the death of any
party by whom he was appointed.
(3) Nothing in this section shall be taken to affect the operation of any
enactment or rule of law by virtue of which any right of action is extinguished by
the death of a person.

4 [Repealed by 2004/270]

124 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

5 Power of Court where arbitrator is removed or appointment of arbitrator is revoked

(1) Where an arbitrator (not being a sole arbitrator) or 2 or more arbitrators (not being all the arbitrators) or an umpire who has not entered on the reference is or are removed by the Court, the Court may, on the application of any party to the submission, appoint a person or persons to act as arbitrator or arbitrators or umpire in place of the person or persons so removed.
(2) Where the appointment of an arbitrator or arbitrators or umpire is revoked by leave of the Court, or a sole arbitrator or all the arbitrators or an umpire who has entered on the reference is or are removed by the Court, the Court may, on the application of any party to the submission, either –
(a) Appoint a person to act as sole arbitrator in place of the person or
persons removed; or
(b) Order that the submission shall cease to have effect with respect to
the dispute referred.
(3) A person appointed by the Court as an arbitrator or umpire shall have
the like power to act in the reference and to make an award as if he had been
appointed under the terms of the submission.
(4) Where it is provided (whether by means of a provision in the submission
or otherwise) that an award under a submission shall be a condition precedent to
the bringing of an action with respect to any matter to which the submission applies,
the Court, if it orders (whether under this section or under any other enactment)
that the submission shall cease to have effect as regards any particular dispute,
may further order that the provision making an award a condition precedent to
the bringing of an action shall also cease to have effect as regards that dispute.

6 Appointment of three arbitrators

(1) Where a submission provides that the reference shall be to 3 arbitrators,
one to be appointed by each party and the third to be appointed by the 2 appointed
by the parties, the submission shall have effect as if it provided for the appointment
of an umpire, and not for the appointment of a third arbitrator, by the 2 arbitrators
appointed by the parties.
(2) Where a submission provides that the reference shall be to 3 arbitrators
to be appointed otherwise than as mentioned in the subsection (1), the award of
any 2 of the arbitrators shall be binding.

7 Provisions relating to umpires

(1) [Spent]
(2) [Spent]
(3) At any time after the appointment of an umpire, however appointed,
the Court may, on the application of any party to the reference and notwithstanding
anything to the contrary in the submission, order that the umpire shall enter on
the reference in lieu of the arbitrators and as if he were a sole arbitrator.

8 Arbitrators and umpires to use due dispatch

(1) The Court may, on the application of any party to a reference, remove
an arbitrator or umpire who fails to use all reasonable dispatch in entering on and
proceeding with the reference and making an award.
(2) An arbitrator or umpire who is removed by the Court under this section
shall not be entitled to receive any remuneration in respect of his services.
(3) Subject to section 11 (2) of the principal Act and to anything to the
contrary in the submission, an arbitrator or umpire shall have power to make an
award at any time.

Arbitration Amendment Act 1938

125
(4) For the purposes of this section the expression “proceeding with a reference” includes, in a case where 2 arbitrators are unable to agree, giving notice of that fact to the parties and to the umpire.

9 [Spent]

10 Additional powers of Court

(1) (a) The Court shall have, for the purpose of and in relation to a reference,
the same power of making orders in respect of any of the matters
set out in the Schedule as it has for the purpose of and in relation to
an action or matter in the Court.
(b) Nothing in paragraph (a) shall be taken to prejudice any power
which may be vested in an arbitrator or umpire of making orders
with respect to any of the matters aforesaid.
(2) Where relief by way of interpleader is granted and it appears to the
Court that the claims in question are matters to which a submission to which the
claimants are parties applies, the Court may direct the issue between the claimants
to be determined under the submission.
(3) Where an application is made to set aside an award the Court may
order that any money made payable by the award shall be brought into Court or
otherwise secured pending the determination of the application.

11 Statement of case by arbitrator or umpire

(1) An arbitrator or umpire may, and shall if so directed by the Court,
state –
(a) Any question of law arising in the course of the reference; or
(b) An award or any part of an award –
in the form of a special case for the decision of the Court.
(2) A special case with respect to an interim award or with respect to a
question of law arising in the course of a reference may be stated, or may be directed
by the Court to be stated, notwithstanding that proceedings under the reference
are still pending.
(3) A decision of the Court under this section shall be deemed to be a
judgment of the Court but no appeal shall lie from the decision of the Court on
any case stated under subsection (1) (a) without the leave of the Court or of the
Court of Appeal.

12 Entry of judgment in terms of award

Where leave is given under section 13 of the principal Act to enforce an
award in the same manner as a judgment or order, judgment may be entered in
terms of the award.

13 Interest on awards

A sum directed to be paid by an award shall, unless the award otherwise
directs, carry interest as from the date of the award and at the same rate as a
judgment debt.
126 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

14 Provision as to costs

(1) (a) Any provision in a submission to the effect that the parties or any
party to it shall in any event pay the whole or any part of the costs
of the reference or award shall be void; and the principal Act shall
in the case of a submission containing any such provision have effect
as if that provision were not contained in it.
(b) Nothing herein shall invalidate such a provision when it is part of
an agreement to submit to arbitration a dispute which has arisen
before the making of such agreement.
(2) If no provision is made by an award with respect to the costs of the
reference, any party to the reference may within 14 days of the publication of the
award, or such further time as the Court may direct, apply to the arbitrator for an
order directing by and to whom such costs shall be paid, and thereupon the
arbitrator shall, after hearing any party who may desire to be heard, amend his
award by adding to it such directions with respect to the payment of the costs of
the reference.

15 Taxation of arbitrator’s or umpire’s fees

(1) If in any case an arbitrator or umpire refuses to deliver his award except
on payment of the fees demanded by him the Court may, on an application for the
purpose, order that the arbitrator or umpire shall deliver the award to the applicant
on payment into Court by the applicant of the fees demanded shall be taxed by
the taxing officer and that out of the money paid into Court there shall be paid out
to the arbitrator or umpire by way of fees such sum as may be found reasonable
on taxation and that the balance of the money, if any, shall be paid out to the
applicant.
(2) An application for the purposes of this section may be made by any
party to the reference unless the fees demanded have been fixed by a written
agreement between him and the arbitrator or umpire.
(3) A taxation of fees under this section may be reviewed in the same
manner as a taxation of costs.
(4) The arbitrator or umpire shall be entitled to appear and be heard on
any taxation or review of taxation under this section.

16 Power of Court to give relief where arbitrator is not impartial or dispute referred involves question of fraud

(1) Where an agreement between any parties provides that disputes which may arise in the future between them shall be referred to an arbitrator named or designated in the agreement and after a dispute has arisen any party applies, on the ground that the arbitrator so named or designated is not or may not be impartial, for leave to revoke the submission or for an injunction to restrain any other party or the arbitrator from proceeding with the arbitration, it shall not be a ground for refusing the application that the said party at the time when he made the agreement knew, or ought to have known, that the arbitrator by reason of his relation towards any other party to the agreement or of his connection with the subject referred might not be capable of impartiality.
(2) Where an agreement between any parties provides that disputes which
may arise in the future between them shall be referred and a dispute which so
arises involves the question whether any such party has been guilty of fraud, the
Court shall, so far as may be necessary to enable that question to be determined
by the Court, have power to order that the agreement shall cease to have effect
and power to give leave to revoke any submission made thereunder.

Arbitration Amendment Act 1938

127
(3) In any case where by virtue of this section the Court has power to order that an agreement shall cease to have effect or to give leave to revoke a submission, the Court may refuse to stay any action brought in breach of the agreement.

17 [Spent]

18 Limitation of time for commencing arbitration proceedings

(1)–(5) [Spent]
(6) Where the terms of an agreement to refer future disputes to arbitration
provide that any claims to which the agreement applies shall be barred unless
notice to appoint an arbitrator is given or an arbitrator is appointed or some other
step to commence arbitration proceedings is taken within a time fixed by the
agreement, and a dispute arises to which the agreement applies, the Court, if it is
of opinion that in the circumstances of the case undue hardship would otherwise
be caused, and notwithstanding that the time so fixed has expires, may, on such
terms, if any, as the justice of the case may require, but without prejudice to the
foregoing provisions of this section, extend the time for such period.

19–21 [Repealed by 2004/270]

SCHEDULE Section 10

MATTERS IN RESPECT OF WHICH THE COURT MAY MAKE ORDERS

(1) Security for costs.

(2) Discovery of documents and interrogatories.

(3) The giving of evidence by affidavit.

(4) Examination on oath of any witness before an officer of the Court or any

other person, and the issue of a commission or request for the examination of a witness

out of the jurisdiction.

(5) The preservation, interim custody, or sale of any goods which are the subject-

matter of the reference.

(6) Securing the amount in dispute in the reference.

(7) The detention, preservation, or inspection of any property or thing which is

the subject of the reference or as to which any question may arise therein, and authorising

for any of the purposes aforesaid any persons to enter upon or into any land or building

in the possession of any party to the reference, or authorising any samples to be taken or

any observation to be made or experiment to be tried which may be necessary or expedient

for the purpose of obtaining full information or evidence.

(8) Interim injunctions or the appointment of a receiver.

128 Niue Laws 2006 Voll

129

ARBITRATION CLAUSES (PROTOCOL) AND THE

ARBITRATION (FOREIGN AWARDS) ACT 1933

1933/4 (NZ) – 28 October 1933

1 Short title PART 2

ENFORCEMENT OF FOREIGN ARBITRAL AWARDS

PART 1 4 Application of Part 2

PROTOCOL ON ARBITRATION CLAUSES 5 Effect of foreign awards

2 Interpretation 6 Conditions for enforcement

3 Stay of court proceedings 7 Evidence

8 Meaning of “final award”

9 Saving

SCHEDULES

To give effect in Niue (1) to a protocol on arbitration clauses signed on behalf of His Majesty at a meeting of the Assembly of the League of Nations held on

24 September 1923 and (2) to a convention on the execution of foreign arbitral awards signed on behalf of His Majesty on 26 September 1927

1 Short title

(1) This Act is the Arbitration Clauses (Protocol) and the Arbitration
(Foreign Awards) Act 1933.
(2) This Act shall be read together with and deemed part of the Arbitration
Act 1908 (the principal Act).

2 Interpretation

PART 1
PROTOCOL ON ARBITRATION CLAUSES
In this Part “the said protocol” means the protocol the terms of which are set forth in Schedule 1.

3 Stay of court proceedings

Notwithstanding anything in the principal Act, if any party to a submission
made in pursuance of an agreement to which the said protocol applies, or any
person claiming through or under him, commences any legal proceedings in any
Court against any other party to the submission, or any person claiming through
or under him, in respect of any matter agreed to be referred, any party to such
legal proceedings may at any time after appearance, and before delivering any
pleadings or taking other steps in the proceedings, apply to that Court to stay the
proceedings, and that Court or a Judge of it, unless satisfied that the agreement or
arbitration has become inoperative or cannot proceed, or that there is not in fact
any dispute between the parties with regard to the matter agreed to be referred
shall make an order staying the proceedings.
130 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
PART 2
ENFORCEMENT OF FOREIGN ARBITRAL AWARDS

4 Application of Part 2

This Part applies to any award made after 28 July 1924 –
(a) In pursuance of an agreement for arbitration to which the protocol
set out in Schedule 1 applies; and
(b) Between persons of whom one is subject to the jurisdiction of one
of the powers which is a party to the Convention and of whom the
other is subject to the jurisdiction of another of those powers; and
(c) In one of the territories to which the Convention applies.

5 Effect of foreign awards

(1) A foreign award shall, subject to this Part be enforceable in Niue either
by action or under section 13 of the principal Act.
(2) Any foreign award which would be enforceable under this Part shall
be treated as binding for all purposes on the persons as between whom it was
made, and may accordingly be relied on by any of those persons by way of defence,
set off, or otherwise in any legal proceedings in Niue, and any references in this
Part to enforcing a foreign award shall be construed as including references to
relying on an award.

6 Conditions for enforcement

(1) In order that a foreign award may be enforceable under this Part it
must have –
(a) Been made in pursuance of an agreement for arbitration which was
valid under the law by which it was governed;
(b) Been made by the tribunal provided for in the agreement or
constituted in manner agreed upon by the parties;
(c) Been made in conformity with the law governing the arbitration
procedure;
(d) Become final in the country in which it was made;
(e) Been in respect of a matter which may lawfully be referred to
arbitration under the law of Niue; –
and the enforcement of it must not be contrary to the public policy or the law of
Niue.
(2) A foreign award shall not be enforceable under this Part if the court dealing with the case is satisfied that –
(a) The award has been annulled in the country in which it was made;
or
(b) The party against whom it is sought to enforce the award was not
given notice of the arbitration proceedings in sufficient time to
enable him to present his case, or was under some legal incapacity
and was not properly represented; or
(c) The award does not deal with all the questions referred or contains
decisions on matters beyond the scope of the agreement for
arbitration:
Provided that, if the award does not deal with all the questions referred, the Court
may either postpone the enforcement of the award or order its enforcement subject
to the giving of such security by the person seeking to enforce it.
(3) If a party seeking to resist the enforcement of a foreign award proves
that there is any ground other than the non-existence of the conditions specified
in section 6 (1) (a), (b) and (c), or the existence of the conditions specified in section

Arbitration Clauses (Protocol) Act 1933

131
6 (2) (b) and (c) entitling him to contest the validity of the award, the Court may, either refuse to enforce the award or adjourn the hearing until after the expiration of such period as appears to the Court to be reasonably sufficient to enable that party to take the necessary steps to have the award annulled by the competent tribunal.

7 Evidence

(1) The party seeking to enforce a foreign award must produce –
(a) The original award or a copy of it duly authenticated in manner
required by the law of the country in which it was made; and
(b) Evidence proving that the award has become final; and
(c) Such evidence as may be necessary to prove that the award is a
foreign award and that the conditions mentioned in section 6 (1)
(a), (b) and (c) are satisfied.
(2) In any case where any document required to be produced under
subsection (1) is in a foreign language, it shall be the duty of the party seeking to
enforce the award to produce a translation certified as correct by a diplomatic or
consular agent of the country to which that party belongs, or certified as correct in
such other manner as may be sufficient under the law of Niue.
(3) Subject to this section, rules of Court may be made under section 70 of
the Niue Act 1966 with respect to the evidence which must be furnished by a
party seeking to enforce an award under this Part.

8 Meaning of “final award”

For the purposes of this Part an award shall not be deemed final if any
proceedings for the purpose of contesting the validity of the award are pending in
the country in which it was made.

9 Saving

Nothing in this Part shall –
(a) Prejudice any rights which any person would have had of enforcing
in Niue any award or of availing himself in Niue of any award if
this Part had not been enacted; or
(b) Apply to any award made on an arbitration agreement governed
by the law of Niue.

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

PROTOCOL ON ARBITRATION CLAUSES

The Undersigned, being duly authorised, declare they accept, on behalf of the countries

which they represent, the following provisions:

1 Each of the Contracting States recognises the validity of an agreement whether

relating to existing or future differences between parties subject respectively to the

jurisdiction of different Contracting States by which the parties to a contract agree to

submit to arbitration all or any differences that may arise in connection with such contract

relating to commercial matters or to any other matter capable of settlement by arbitration,

whether or not the arbitration is to take place in a country to whose jurisdiction none of

the parties is subject.

132 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Each Contracting State reserves the right to limit the obligation mentioned above to contracts which are considered as commercial under its national law. Any Contracting State which avails itself of this right will notify the Secretary-General of the League of Nations, in order that the other Contracting States may be so informed.

2 The arbitral procedure, including the constitution of the arbitral tribunal, shall be governed by the will of the parties and by the law of the country in whose territory the arbitration takes place.

The Contracting States agree to facilitate all steps in the procedure which require to be taken in their own territories, in accordance with the provisions of their law governing arbitral procedure applicable to existing differences.

3 Each Contracting State undertakes to ensure the execution by its authorities and in accordance with the provisions of its national laws of arbitral awards made in its own territory under the preceding articles.

4 The tribunals of the Contracting Parties, on being seized of a dispute regarding a contract made between persons to whom article 1 applies and including an arbitration agreement, whether referring to present or future differences, which is valid in virtue of the said article and capable of being carried into effect, shall refer the parties on the application of either of them to the decision of the arbitrators.

Such reference shall not prejudice the competence of the judicial tribunals in case the agreement or the arbitration cannot proceed or become inoperative.

5 The present protocol, which shall remain open for signature by all States, shall be ratified. The ratifications shall be deposited as soon as possible with the Secretary- General of the League of Nations, who shall notify such deposit to all the signatory States.

6 The present protocol shall come into force as soon as 2 ratifications have been deposited. Thereafter it will take effect, in the case of each Contracting State, one month after the notification by the Secretary-General of the deposit of its ratification.

7 The present protocol may be denounced by any Contracting State as giving one year ’s notice. Denunciation shall be effected by a notification addressed to the Secretary-General of the League, who will immediately transmit copies of such notification to all the other signatory States and inform them of the date on which it was received. The denunciation shall take effect one year after the date on which it was notified to the Secretary-General, and shall operate only in respect of the notifying State.

8 The Contracting States may declare that their acceptance of the present protocol does not include any or all of the under-mentioned territories – that is to say, their colonies, overseas possessions or territories, protectorates, or the territories over which they exercise a mandate.

The said States may subsequently adhere separately on behalf of any territory thus excluded. The Secretary-General of the League of Nations shall be informed as soon as possible of such adhesions. He shall notify such adhesions to all signatory States. They will take effect one month after the notification by the Secretary-General to all signatory States.

The Contracting States may also denounce the protocol separately on behalf of any of the territories referred to above Article 7 applies to such denunciation.

SCHEDULE 2

Convention on the Execution of Foreign Arbitral Awards

Article 1

In the territories of any High Contracting Party to which the present convention applies,

an arbitral award made in pursuance of an agreement, whether relating to existing or

future differences (hereinafter called “a submission to arbitration”) covered by the Protocol

on Arbitration Clauses, opened at Geneva on 24 September 1923, shall be recognised as

binding and shall be enforced in accordance with the rules of the procedure of the territory

where the award is relied upon, provided that the said award has been made in a territory

of one of the High Contracting Parties to which the present convention applies and between

persons who are subject to the jurisdiction of one of the High Contracting Parties.

Arbitration Clauses (Protocol) Act 1933

133

To obtain such recognition or enforcement, it shall, further, be necessary –

(a) That the award has been made in pursuance of a submission to arbitration

which is valid under the law applicable to it;

(b) That the subject matter of the award is capable of settlement by arbitration

under the law of the country in which the award is sought to be relied

upon;

(c) That the award has been made by the arbitral tribunal provided for in the

submission to arbitration, or constituted in the manner agreed upon by

the parties and in conformity with the law governing the arbitration

procedure;

(d) That the award has become final in the country in which it has been made,

in the sense that it will not be considered as such if it is open to opposition,

appel or pourvoi en cassation (in the countries where such forms of procedure

exist) or if it is proved that any proceedings for the purpose of contesting

the validity of the award are pending;

(e) That the recognition or enforcement of the award is not contrary to the

public policy or to the principles of the law of the country in which it is

sought to be relied upon.

Article 2

Even if the conditions laid down in article 1 are fulfilled, recognition and enforcement of

the award shall be refused in the Court is satisfied –

(a) That the award has been annulled in the country in which it was made;

(b) That the party against whom it is sought to use the award was not given

notice of the arbitration proceeding in sufficient time to enable him to

present his case; or that, being under a legal incapacity, he was not properly

represented;

(c) That the award does not deal with the differences contemplated by or

falling within the terms of the submission to arbitration or that it contains

decisions on matters beyond the scope of the submission to arbitration.

If the award has not covered all the questions submitted to the arbitral tribunal,

the competent authority of the country where recognition or enforcement of the award is

sought can, if it think fit, postpone such recognition or enforcement or grant it subject to

such guarantee as that authority may decide.

Article 3

If the party against whom the award has been made proves that, under the law

governing the arbitration procedure, there is a ground, other than the grounds referred to

in article 1 (a) and (c), and article 2 (b) and (c), entitling him to contest the validity of the

award in a Court of law, the court may, if it thinks fit, either refuse recognition or

enforcement of the award or adjourn the consideration of it, giving such party a reasonable

time within which to have the award annulled by the competent tribunal.

Article 4

The party relying upon an award or claiming its enforcement must supply, in particular:

(1) The original award or a copy of duly authenticated under the requirements

of the law of the country in which it was made;

(2) Documentary or other evidence to prove that the award has become final, in

the sense defined in article 1 (d), in the country in which it was made;

(3) When necessary, documentary or other evidence to prove that the conditions

laid down in article (1) and (2) (a) and (c) have been fulfilled.

A translation of the award and of the other documents mentioned in this article

into the official language of the country where the award is sought to be relied upon may

be demanded. Such translation must be certified correct by a diplomatic or consular agent

of the country to which the party who seeks to rely upon the award belongs or by a

sworn translator of the country where the award is sought to be relied upon.

134 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Article 5

The provisions of the above articles shall not deprive any interested party of the

right of availing himself of an arbitral award in the manner and to the extent allowed by

the law or the treaties of the country where such award is sought to be relied upon.

Article 6

The present convention applies only to arbitral awards made after the coming

into force of the Protocol on Arbitration Clauses, opened at Geneva on 24 September

1923.

Article 7

The present convention, which will remain open to the signature of all the

signatories of the Protocol of 1923 on Arbitration Clauses, shall be ratified.

It may be ratified only on behalf of those members of the League of Nations and

non-member States on whose behalf the Protocol of 1923 shall have been ratified.

Ratifications shall be deposited as soon as possible with the Secretary-General of

the League of Nations, who will notify such deposit to all the signatories.

Article 8

The present convention shall come into force 3 months after it shall have been

ratified on behalf of 2 High Contracting Parties. Thereafter, it shall take effect, in the case

of each High Contracting Party, 3 months after the deposit of the ratification on its behalf

with the Secretary-General of the League of Nations.

Article 9

The present convention may be denounced on behalf of any member of the League

or non-member State. Denunciation shall be notified in writing to the Secretary-General

of the League of Nations, who will immediately send a copy of it, certified to be in

conformity with the notification, to all other Contracting Parties, at the same time informing

them of the date on which he received it.

The denunciation shall come into force only in respect of the High Contracting

Party which shall have notified it, and one year after such notification shall have reached

the Secretary-General of the League of Nations.

The denunciation of the Protocol on Arbitration Clauses shall entail, ipso facto, the

denunciation of the present convention.

Article 10

The present convention does not apply to the colonies, protectorates, or territories

under suzerainty or mandate of any High Contracting Party unless they are specially

mentioned.

The application of this convention to one or more of such colonies, protectorates

or territories to which the Protocol on Arbitration Clauses, opened at Geneva on 24

September 1923, applies, can be effected at any time by means of a declaration addressed

to the Secretary-General of the League of Nations by one of the High Contracting Parties.

Such declaration shall take effect 3 months after the deposit of it.

The High Contracting Parties can at any time denounce the convention for all or

any of the colonies, protectorates, or territories referred to above. Article 9 hereof applies

to such denunciation.

Article 11

A certified copy of the present convention shall be transmitted by the Secretary-General

of the League of Nations to every member of the League of Nations and to every non­

member State which signs the same.

135

ARCHIVES ACT 1992

1992/166 – 5 November 1992

1

Short title

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

2

Interpretation

3

Application

PART 2

ADMINISTRATION

4

Archives Office

5

Archivist

6

Delegation of the Archivist’s powers

PART 3

CUSTODY AND PRESERVATION OF ARCHIVES

7

Deposit of public records

To provide for the better preservation of the public records of Niue

1 Short title

This is the Archives Act 1992.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
PART 1
PRELIMINARY
“Archives Office” means the National Archives of Niue established under this Act;
“Archivist” means the Archivist appointed under this Act;
“Government office” means any ministry, department, office, agency or
instrument of any kind of the legislative or executive or judicial
government of Niue; and includes any office or corporation or other
body declared by Cabinet to be a Government office for the purposes
of this Act;
“public records” means all such documentary materials of any kind, nature,
or description which have been drawn up, made, received, acquired or
used in the course of legislative, administrative or executive transactions
or in proceedings in any Court, together with all exhibits and other
material evidence which form part or are annexed to or are otherwise
related to specific documents, which are or are required to be in the
custody of any servant of the Government or Government office, or
which may at the commencement of this Act or thereafter be transferred
to or acquired by the Archives Office.
136 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

3 Application

Nothing in this Act or in any regulations made under this Act shall apply
with respect to any public record which has been drawn up, received, acquired or
used by any Government office if such record discloses any information which is
required to be kept secret under any enactment.

4 Archives Office

PART 2
ADMINISTRATION
(1) There shall continue to be established an Archives Office to be known as the “National Archives of Niue” wherein shall be stored for better preservation such of the public records of Niue as are transferred to or acquired by the Archives Office under this Act.
(2) Subject to any general or special directions which may be given by Cabinet, the Archivist may by contract or bequest or in any like manner acquire for the Archives Office all such original records, manuscripts and other documentary materials, or copies, or replicas of it, other than public records, as the Archivist may deem necessary or desirable to secure, and all such materials shall be deemed to be public records of Niue for the purposes of this Act.

5 Archivist

There shall be appointed as a member of the Public Service an Archivist
who shall, subject to any directions given to the Archivist by Cabinet, be charged
with the care, custody, control and administration of the public records in the
Archives Office and the public access to it and with the performance of any other
duties prescribed by this Act.

6 Delegation of the Archivist’s powers

(1) The Archivist may delegate in writing to any person or class of persons
any of his powers under this Act, except the power of authorising the destruction
or disposal of public records.
(2) (a) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions
attached by the Archivist, the person to whom any powers are
delegated under this section may exercise those powers in the same
manner and with the same effect as if they had been conferred on
such person directly by this section and not by delegation.
(b) No such delegation shall prevent the exercise of any power by the
Archivist.
(3) Every person purporting to act pursuant to any delegation shall, in the
absence of proof to the contrary, be presumed to be acting under the terms of the
delegation.
(4) Every delegation under this section shall, until it is revoked, continue
in force under its tenor, notwithstanding the fact that the Archivist by whom it
was made may have ceased to hold office, and shall continue to have effect as if
made by his successor in office.

Archives Act 1992

137
PART 3
CUSTODY AND PRESERVATION OF ARCHIVES

7 Deposit of public records

(1) All public records of the age of 15 years or over (other than those which
under any Act are required to be held in the custody of a special person or Government office) which in the opinion of the Archivist are of sufficient value to warrant their preservation as –
(a) Evidence of the organisation, functions, and transactions of the Government office in which they were originally made or received; or
(b) Evidence of public or private personal or property rights or civic rights; or
(c) Containing historical or general information, shall be transferred to the custody of the Archivist and be deposited in the Archives Office.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) –
(a) Where the Archivist is satisfied that the deposit in the Archives
Office of any particular public record of the age of 15 years or over
would unduly prejudice the effective administration of any
Government office, the Archivist shall defer the deposit of that
public record for such period as may be agreed upon between the
Archivist and the administrative head of the Government office
affected;
(b) Where the administrative head of the Government office having
the possession or control of any public record satisfies the Archivist
that by reason of its secret or confidential nature it would not be in
the public interest immediately to deposit that record in the Archives
Office, the Archivist shall defer the deposit of that public record for
such period as may be agreed upon between that administrative
head and the Archivist;
(c) Where the Minister in charge of any Government office certifies
that in his opinion any specified public record or specified class of
public records in the custody or control of the Government office
contains information the release of which may adversely affect the
security of Niue or relations between the Government of Niue and
the Government of any other country, the deposit in the Archives
Office or that public record or of public records of that class shall be
deferred for such period or shall be made subject to such conditions
as to access or otherwise as that Minister directs;
(d) Where the deposit of any public record in the Archives Office is
deferred as aforesaid, the Archivist may prescribe any conditions
the Archivist thinks fit to ensure the safe preservation of any such
record during the time they are kept in a Government office.
(3) Any public records deposited under subsection (2) may be deposited
unconditionally or, if the administrative head of the Government office making
the deposit so requires, shall be deposited subject to such conditions as to access
and otherwise as may be agreed upon by the Archivist and the administrative
head of that office.
(4) Where the administrative head of any Government office and the
Archivist are unable to agree as to whether or not the deposit of any records in the
Archives Office should be deferred or as to the period for which that deposit should
be deferred or as to the conditions as to access and otherwise on which any public
records should be deposited, that question shall be determined by Cabinet, whose
decision shall be final.
138 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

8 Records of less than 15 years

(1) The Archivist may allow the deposit in the Archives Office of public
records of less than 15 years of age if the Archivist considers that they are of
sufficient value for deposit.
(2) Any deposit of public records under subsection (1) may be subject to
any special conditions imposed by the administrative head of the Government
office making the deposit.

9 Records not in the Archives Office

(1) The Archivist shall be entitled to inspect any public records that are for
the time being in the possession or under the control of any Government office
and give such instructions as to their safe preservation and such advise as to their
efficient and economical administration and management as the Archivist
considers necessary.
(2) Nothing in this section shall be deemed to authorise the Archivist to
inspect the contents of any public records –
(a) Which by law are forbidden to be communicated to the Archivist;
or
(b) Which are secret or confidential;
except with the consent of the administrative head of the Government office having
the custody of it.

10 Return of public records

Where the administrative head of the Government office by which any
public record was deposited in the Archives, or the administrative head of the
successor of that Government office, satisfies the Archivist that the public record
is required for use in that Government office, the Archivist shall return such public
record to the custody of that Government office for such period as may be agreed
upon between the Archivist and the administrative head, and subject to such
conditions as the Archivist may prescribe to ensure the safe custody and
preservation of that public record during the time it is kept in that Government
office.

11 Public records to be surrendered

Where any public record is in the custody or possession of any person other
than a public officer or other person authorised to have such custody or possession
in his official capacity, that person shall, on demand in writing by the Archivist,
deposit that public record in the Archives Office or such other Government office
as the Archivist may direct.

12 Public records not to be destroyed

(1) No person shall destroy or otherwise dispose of, or authorise the
destruction or other disposal of, any public record of any kind whatsoever that is
in his possession or under his control, except with the consent of the Archivist
given under this Act.
(2) Before authorising the destruction of any public record or any class of
it, the Archivist may consult with any person whom the Archivist considers
qualified to give advice as to the value of permanent preservation.

13 Routine destruction of public records

The Archivist may authorise the immediate destruction, or the destruction
after the expiration of such specified time as may be agreed upon between the

Archives Act 1992

139
Archivist and the administrative head of the Government office concerned, or any specified public record or class of public records that –
(a) By reason of their number, kind or routine nature do not possess any enduring value for preservation in the Archives Office; and
(b) Are not required for reference purposes in any Government office after action on them is completed, or after the expiration of such period of years from the date on which action on them is completed as may be agreed upon between the Archivist and the administrative head of the Government office concerned.

14 Access to public records

(1) Except as may be otherwise provided by enactment, and subject to the
conditions under which any records are deposited, all records deposited in the
Archives Office shall be available for public reference:
Provided that –
(a) The Archivist may, for any good cause, withhold access to any
specified public record or any specified class of public records in
his custody subject to the right of the person so denied access to
appeal to Cabinet, whose decision on it shall be final;
(b) Any public record deposited in the Archives Office by any court
and containing any information relating to the trial or punishment
of any particular person, may be inspected only by a person
authorised by the Chief Justice in that behalf.
(2) Nothing in this section shall limit the powers of any competent Court
to order the production of any public record of Niue.
(3) Notwithstanding the other provisions of this section and subject to
subsection (1) (b), Cabinet may, by causing written notice to be given to the
Archivist, withhold access either generally or by any person or class of persons to
any specified public record or to any specified class of public records in the custody
of the Archivist.
(4) Any person may, with the consent of the Archivist, make or cause to be
made at his own expense copies of or extras from any public archives which are
available for public reference under this section.

15 Publication of public records

On the recommendation of the Archivist, Cabinet may authorise the
publication of any public records deposited in the Archives Office and available
for public reference which Cabinet considers to be of sufficient interest to warrant
their publication.

16 Copyright

(1) Nothing in this Act shall derogate from any provision of the law relating
to copyright in relation to anything contained in any public records deposited in
the Archives Office.
(2) Where any person publishes any work containing any passage from
any public record deposited in the Archives Office, he shall in that publication
acknowledge the source from which that passage is taken.
140 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

17 Archives Office seal

The Archivist shall cause to be made a seal for the Archives Office with
which all certified copies issuing out of the Office shall be sealed.

18 Certified copies

Any copy of any public record of Niue in the custody of the Archivist which
is certified by the Archivist to be a true copy of such public record shall be received
as evidence of the contents of such record in all courts within Niue.

19 Regulations

(1) Subject to subsection (3), Cabinet may make regulations for any purpose
for which regulations are contemplated by this Act and all such other regulations
as may in Cabinet’s opinion be necessary or expedient for giving effect to this Act
and for the due administration of it.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), Cabinet may make
regulations –
(a) Regulating the transfer of public records from any Government
office to the Archives Office or any record centre or other repository
which may be established for the purposes of this Act;
(b) Regulating the manner of destruction or other disposal of valueless
public records;
(c) Regulating the admission of the public to the Archives Office and
the use by the public of public records of Niue deposited in the
Archives Office, and the fees to be charged for such admission;
(d) Providing for the custody and preservation of records deposited in
the Archives Office under section 4 (2) and prescribing the fees to
be charged for that custody and preservation.
(3) The Chief Justice may make rules of court with regard to matters referred
to in subsection (1) (a), (b) or (c) in cases where the public documents concerned
relate to proceedings in any court.

20 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person shall commit an offence who –
(a) Wilfully or negligently damages any public records; or
(b) Wilfully or negligently disposes of or destroys any public records
otherwise than under this Act; or
(c) Does any act in contravention of or fails to comply with this Act.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this Act shall be liable
on conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.
(3) The court by which any person is convicted of an offence against
subsection (1) may, in addition to any penalty imposed for the offence, direct that
such person shall not be entitled to have access to the Archives Office for such
period as the court thinks fit.
141

ARMS ACT 1975

1975/4 – February 1975

13A Offence to discharge firearm near residence

To make provision for the importation acquisition and possession of firearms and ammunition

1 Short title

This is the Arms Act 1975.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Arms Officer” means a person appointed as an Arms Officer by the Niue
Public Service Commission for the purpose of this Act, and in default
of such appointment means the Chief Officer of Police;
“explosive” includes any article of which an explosive forms a part and
which is capable of a destructive effect by way of an explosion;
“firearm” includes any weapon from which a missile can be discharged by
the force of an explosion or by the force of any compressed gas or
compressed air, and includes a weapon which for the time being is not
capable of discharging a missile but which by the replacement of any
component part or parts, or the correction of any defect, would be so
capable, and also includes any weapon which is for the time being
dismantled, but subject to section 13 (4) does not include any firearm
of the type commonly known as humane killers, or bolt or stun guns;
“owner” as used in relation to a firearm includes any person for the time
being in possession of or having control of it;
“pistol” means any firearm which is designed or adapted to be held and
fired with one hand; and includes any firearm that is less than 30 inches
in length;
142 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“shot-gun” means a firearm having a smooth-bore barrel and primarily designed for sporting purposes and to discharge pellets of shot only;
“unlawful weapon” means any pistol, machine gun, rifle, air-gun, and any other class of firearm except a shot-gun.

3 Permits for import of firearms

(1) No person shall bring or cause to be brought or sent into Niue any
ammunition or any firearm otherwise than under a permit issued to him for that
purpose by the Arms Officer in the appropriate form contained in Schedule 1 and
on payment of the appropriate fee prescribed in Schedule 4.
(2) Before issuing such a permit the Arms Officer may require the applicant
to produce for examination and testing the firearm or such samples of any firearms
or ammunition referred to in the application as he shall think fit and may in his
discretion refuse to grant a permit for any or all of the firearms or ammunition
referred to in the application.
(3) The issue of any permit under this section shall be subject to such
conditions as the Arms Officer may impose.
(4) The Arms Officer may at any time revoke any permit to import firearms
or ammunition issued under this section.
(5) If any constable or any officer of Customs has reasonable grounds to
suspect that firearms have been brought into Niue in breach of this section, or
have been brought into Niue territorial waters and are intended to be brought
into Niue in breach of this section, that constable or officer may seize such firearms
or ammunition and detain the same.
(6) Notwithstanding subsection (1) it shall not be lawful for any person to
import into Niue otherwise than in a manufactured cartridge for any firearms any
dynamite, gelignite, nitroglycerine, blasting powder, or any other explosive of
any nature whatever except by and on behalf of the Government of Niue.

4 Permits for possession

(1) Subject to this Act, no person shall, whether by way of purchase or in
any other manner, procure possession of any firearm or ammunition otherwise
than under a permit issued to him for that purpose by the Arms Officer in the
form contained in Schedule 2.
(2) No person shall, whether by way of sale or in any other manner, deliver
possession of any firearm or ammunition to any person other than to a person
entitled to obtain the firearm or ammunition by virtue of any permit referred to in
subsection (1).
(3) A permit may be issued by the Arms Officer on payment of the fee
prescribed in Schedule 4.
(4) Every person who commits or attempts to commit a breach of this
section is guilty of an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or to
both such fine and imprisonment, and the burden of proving the existence and
terms of any such permit as aforesaid shall be on the defendant.
(5) Every permit issued under this section shall remain in force for such
period not exceeding 28 days as may be specified in the permit.
(6) Every such permit issued may be revoked by the Arms Officer at any
time.

Arms Act 1975

143

5 Sale to and possession by young persons

(1) It shall not be lawful to sell or supply any firearm or ammunition to
any person apparently under the age of 18 years.
(2) No person under the age of 18 years shall use or carry or have in his
possession any firearm, explosive or ammunition.
(3) Any person who commits or attempts to commit a breach of this section
shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

6 Registration of firearms

(1) No person shall be in possession of any firearm for a period longer
than 28 days unless he is registered as the owner of it under this section.
(2) Registration under this section shall be affected by paying the fee
prescribed in Schedule 4 and obtaining a certificate of registration from the Arms
Officer in the form contained in Schedule 3.
(3) The Arms Officer may, before issuing a certificate of registration, require
the firearm to be produced for his inspection and may refuse to issue a certificate
if he considers that the firearm is in an unsafe condition, and may, if he considers
the firearm to be a danger to the public, confiscate such firearm.
(4) A certificate of registration may, in the discretion of the Arms Officer,
include the name of any employee or of any member of the family of the owner
who has attained the age of 18 years, and, notwithstanding anything to the contrary
contained in this Act, any person whose name is for the time being included in a
certificate as aforesaid may be given lawful possession of the firearm.
(5) Any such name may be included in a certificate of registration at any
time by the Arms Officer and may, at the request of the owner, be removed at any
time.
(6) Any person whose name is included in a certificate of registration under subsection (4) or subsection (5) shall for the purpose of section 7, be deemed to be registered as an owner of the firearm.
(7) (a) Every certificate of registration issued under this section shall expire on 30 June next following the issue and may be renewed by application made to a constable and on payment of the prescribed fee.
(b) Such application shall contain such particulars as may be prescribed by the Arms Officer.
(8) (a) The Arms Officer may, before renewing any certificate of registration, call on the registered owner to produce the firearm for his inspection and if he considers such firearm to be unsafe he shall seize the firearm and refuse to renew the certificate of registration.
(b) Any registered owner who fails to account for the non-possession of such firearm shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(9) If any certificate issued under this section is accidentally destroyed, defaced or lost the Arms Officer may, if he is satisfied as to the destruction, defacement or loss of such certificate, and upon payment of the prescribed fee issue to the person in whose name the certificate was originally granted a new certificate and endorse on it a statement reciting such destruction, defacement, or loss and such new certificate shall have the same force and effect as the original certificate.
(10) (a) Every person who commits a breach of this section is guilty of an
offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit.
144 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) In any prosecution for such an offence, if the defendant is proved to have been in possession of the firearm, the burden of proving that he was the holder of a valid certificate of registration in respect thereof for more than 28 days or that he was lawfully in possession of it under this section shall lie on the defendant.

7 Registration may be refused or existing certificate revoked

(1) No person shall be registered as the owner of any firearm who, in the
opinion of the Arms Officer, is not a fit and proper person to be in possession of
the firearm.
(2) If any person who is registered as the owner of any firearm is, in the
opinion of the Arms Officer, not a fit and proper person to be in possession of the
firearm or if, in the opinion of the Arms Officer, the firearm is unsafe, the Arms
Officer may, by notice in writing under his hand, revoke the certificate of
registration, and the person so registered shall on demand surrender the certificate
to any constable.
(3) On the revocation of a certificate of registration under this section the
person to whom the certificate was issued shall cease to be the registered owner
of the firearm to which it relates, whether or not the certificate had been
surrendered.

8 Unregistered firearm to be surrendered

(1) On the revocation of any certificate of registration under section 7 or
on the refusal of the Arms Officer to issue a certificate of registration or on refusal
of renewal of registration under an application under section 9, the owner or other
person for the time being in possession of the firearm to which the certificate or
application relates, shall, on demand deliver the firearm to a constable.
(2) The owner of any firearm in respect of which an application for a
certificate of registration or renewal of registration has been refused may, at any
time within 3 months thereafter or such longer period as the Arms Officer allows,
sell or otherwise dispose of the firearm to a person approved for the purpose by
the Arms Officer unless the Arms Officer considers that the weapon is unsafe, in
which case he shall prohibit such sale or disposition.
(3) Subject to subsection (2), all firearms delivered to the Arms Officer under
this section may be detained by him, and may, in the discretion of the Minister of
Police become the property of the Government of Niue, free and discharged from
all right, title, or interest possessed in respect of it by any other person.
(4) The Minister of Finance shall without further appropriation than this
section pay out of the Treasury fund compensation for the value of all firearms
delivered to the Arms Officer under this section and which have become the
property of the Government of Niue as provided, the amount of such compensation
to be agreed upon between the Minister and the owner, and in default of agreement
to be determined by the Court.
(5) Every person who commits a breach of this section is guilty of an offence
and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months
or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

9 Possession of unlawful weapon

(1) Except as provided in subsection (2), every person who is at any time
in possession of an unlawful weapon, or of any part or parts of an unlawful
weapon, or of any part or parts specially intended or adapted for use as part of an
unlawful weapon, or any ammunition for an unlawful weapon, shall forthwith

Arms Act 1975

145
cause the weapon or the parts or the ammunition to be destroyed, exported from
Niue or delivered to the Arms Officer.
(2) (a) The Minister of Police may, in writing authorise any person in any
special case and for any special reason to have in his possession
any unlawful weapon subject to such conditions as to use or custody
as the Arms Officer may impose.
(b) Any such authorisation may be revoked at any time by the Minister
without notice.
(3) Every person who is in possession of any weapon or parts or
ammunition contrary to this section or who fails to comply with any condition
imposed under subsection (2) commits an offence and shall be liable on such
conviction to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units or to both.

10 Carriage or possession of arms

(1) No person shall carry or be in possession of any firearm, ammunition,
explosive, or dangerous weapon except for some lawful, proper, and sufficient
purpose and the burden of proving such purpose shall lie on the defendant.
(2) No person who, while under the influence of drink or drugs to such an
extent as to be incapable of having proper control of the firearm, shall be in charge
of any firearm.
(3) Every person who commits a breach of this section commits an offence
and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months
or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or to both.

11 Unlawful acquisition of firearms

Every person who procures or attempts to procure or conspires to procure
the possession of any firearm, ammunition or explosive by way of trespass or
otherwise without lawful right or title commits an offence and shall be liable on
conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units or to both.

12 Presenting firearms at any person

(1) Every person who except for some lawful and sufficient purpose,
presents a firearm, whether loaded or unloaded, at any other person, commits an
offence and shall be liable on conviction to a term of imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or to both.
(2) Every person who, except for some lawful or sufficient purpose,
presents at any person anything which, in the circumstances, is likely to lead that
person to believe that it is a firearm commits an offence, and shall be liable on
conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units or to both.

13 Careless use of a firearm

(1) Every person who causes bodily injury to or the death of any person
by carelessly using a firearm commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year or to a fine not exceeding 5
penalty units, or to both.
(2) Every person who has in his charge or under his control a firearm
loaded, with a cartridge or cartridges, whether in its breech, barrel, chamber or
magazine, and who leaves that firearm in any place in such circumstances as to
endanger the life of any person without taking reasonable precautions to avoid
146 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
any such danger commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or to both.
(3) It shall be no defence to the crime of manslaughter that the guilty act or omission proved against the person charged upon the indictment is an act or omission constituting an offence against this section.
(4) For the purposes of this section ‘firearm’ shall be deemed to include any firearm of the type commonly known as humane killers, or bolt or stun guns.

13A Offence to discharge firearm near residence

(1) A person must not discharge a firearm within 100 metres of a building
being used as a residence.
(2) A person who fails to comply with subsection (1) is guilty of an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or for a second
or subsequent offence to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 6 months or both such fine and imprisonment.
(3) Subsection (1) does not apply to a constable in the execution of his or
her duties.

14 Obstruction of police

Every person who obstructs a constable in the exercise of any right or search,
seizure, or detention conferred by this Act commits an offence, and shall be liable
on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not
exceeding 1 penalty unit or to both.

15 Arrest of offenders

Any person reasonably suspected of having committed an offence against
this Act which is punishable by imprisonment may be arrested by any constable
without warrant.

16 Occupier of premises deemed to be in possession of arms

For the purposes of this Act every person in occupation of any land or
building on which any firearms, ammunition, or explosives are found shall, though
not to the exclusion of the liability of any other person, be deemed to be in
possession of those arms, ammunition, or explosives, unless he proves that they
were in the possession of some other person or satisfies the court that he had no
reasonable ground for believing that they were on such land or building.

17 Search of suspected persons

(1) If a constable has reasonable grounds to suspect that any person being
in a public place is carrying or is in possession of any firearm, ammunition, or
explosive in breach of this Act the member may without warrant search that person
or any vehicle, package, or other thing there in his possession or under his control,
and may detain that person for the purpose of any such search, and may seize any
such firearm, ammunition, or explosive, and detain the same.
(2) If any constable has reasonable grounds to suspect that any person has
in his possession or under his control in any place any firearm, ammunition or
explosive, and that the person is of unsound mind, or is under the influence of
drink or a drug to such an extent as to be incapable of having proper control of the
firearm, ammunition, or explosive, or may kill or do bodily injury to himself or
any other person, the constable may, without warrant, search that person or place
and may detain that person for the purpose of any such search, and may seize any
such firearm, ammunition, or explosive and detain the same.

Arms Act 1975

147

18 Search of land or building for arms

If the Chief Officer of Police has reason to suspect that there is in any house,
building, land, vehicle, vessel, or other premises any firearms, ammunition, or
explosives in respect of which any offence against this Act has been or is about to
be committed or which may be evidence of any such offence, the Chief Officer of
Police, or constable authorised by him in writing may enter any such house,
building, land, vehicle, vessel, or premises, and either by day or by night, and
search the same or any part of it, and may seize any firearms, ammunition or
explosives found there, and detain the same.

19 Application to Government

Nothing in this Act shall render unlawful the importation, carriage or
possession of firearms, ammunition, or explosives belonging to the Government
of Niue and lawfully in the possession of any constable or any armed forces of the
Government.

20 Restoration of articles seized under this Act

On application to the Court a Judge may make such order as he thinks just
and expedient for the restoration of any firearms, ammunition, or explosives seized
and detained in pursuance of the right of search, seizure, or detention conferred
by this Act.

21 Forfeitures

When any person is convicted of using, carrying, or having in possession
any arms, ammunition, or explosives in breach of this Act, the convicting Court
may, as part of the conviction, order that any such arms, ammunition, or explosives
shall be forfeited, and shall hereupon become forfeited to the Government of Niue
accordingly, and may be disposed of in such manner as the Arms Officer directs.

22 Authorising disposal of firearms

Without limiting the operation of any other provisions of this Act as to the
disposal of firearms, ammunition, or explosives seized or detained under this
Act, any such firearms, ammunition, or explosives that have been detained for
not less than 2 years may be disposed of in such manner as the Arms Officer may
direct.

23 Persons acting under authority

No action, claim, or demand whatsoever shall lie or be made or allowed by
or in favour of any person against the Government of Niue, or any person lawfully
acting in execution or intended execution of this Act, save only in respect of any
compensation that is payable under the express provisions of this Act.

24 Regulations

(1) The Minister of Police, acting by and with the advice and consent of
Cabinet may make regulations for any purpose for which regulations are
contemplated by this Act and for the due administration of it.
(2) In particular, and without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing
power, such regulations may provide for the following matters –
(a) Prescribing the form of permits, and certificates under this Act and
the conditions and manner of their grant:
Provided that unless and until regulations shall be made adding to
or amending the forms of permits and certificates contained or the
148 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
fees specified in the Schedules, such forms of permits and certificates contained and such fees specified shall be the forms and the fees for the several matters referred to in the Schedules;
(b) Making provision for the marking of firearms with identifying marks before the issue of certificates of registration;
(c) Applying the provisions of this Act to any class of firearm not
included in this Act;
(d) Excluding any firearms from this Act;
(e) Declaring any firearm shotgun or weapon to be an unlawful
weapon;
(f) Generally for any other purpose deemed by the Minister of Police
to be necessary for giving effect to the full intent and purposes of
this Act.

25 [Spent]

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Form 1A Section 3

PERMIT TO IMPORT A FIREARM

ARMS ACT 1975 SECTION 3

No.

........................................................... of ....................................... (occupation) ......................... is permitted to bring or cause to be brought into Niue within .............................. months from the date hereof the firearm mentioned in the Schedule.

Dated at Alofi this ........................... day of ............................... 20 .......... .

Arms Officer

SCHEDULE

Type ................................................................... Country of Origin .......................................... Gauge or Calibre Lawful/Unlawful (delete that which is ......

inapplicable)

Conditions ........................................................

Arms Act 1975

Form 1B PERMIT TO IMPORT AMMUNITION No.

ARMS ACT 1975 SECTION 3

149

........................................................... , of ...................................... (occupation) ....................... is permitted to bring or cause to be brought into Niue within ............................................. months from the date hereof the ammunition described in the Schedule.

Arms Officer

SCHEDULE

Quantity .................................. Calibre .......................... Country of Origin ............................

.................................................. Conditions .................................................................................

........................................................... , of ...................................... (occupation) ....................... Date of Birth .................................... being a person of/or over the age of 16 years

is hereby permitted to obtain possession of the firearm mentioned in the Schedule.

Arms Officer

SCHEDULE

Type .................................................................. Gauge or Calibre ............................................. Description (numbers, marks, stamped on, etc.) .................................................................... Lawful weapon/Unlawful weapon (delete that which is inapplicable).

SCHEDULE 3

Form 3 Section 6

CERTIFICATE OF REGISTRATION OF FIREARM ARMS ACT 1975 SECTION 6

........................................................ , of ...................................... (Occupation) ......................... has this day been registered as the owner of: (Describe firearm – numbers, marks, calibre)

being a lawful/an unlawful (delete one) weapon.

The names of the following persons are included in this certificate under section 6(4) of the Arms Act 1975.

150 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Full Name Address Occupation Age

Dated at Alofi this ........................... day of ............................... 20 .......... .


Arms Officer

SCHEDULE 4
Permit to import firearm $80.00
Certificate to register firearm for the first time $30.00
Annual licence $15.00
151

ASSEMBLY MEMBERS’ SUPERANNUATION ACT 1984

1984/98 – 1 April 1984

1

2

3

4

Short title

Interpretation

Assembly Members Superannuation

Account

Contributions by Members

5

6

7

8

9

Subsidy from Niue Government Account

Retiring allowance

Death of a Member

[Spent]

Provision for payment

To establish a superannuation scheme for

Members of the Assembly

1 Short title

This is the Assembly Members’ Superannuation Act 1984.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Member” means a Member of the Assembly established under article 16
of the Niue Constitution and includes the Premier, Cabinet Ministers
and the Speaker;
“Superannuation Account” means the Assembly Members Superannuation
Account established under section 3.

3 Assembly Members’ Superannuation Account

(1) There is hereby established within the Niue Government Accounts an
account to be known as the Assembly Members’ Superannuation Account.
(2) There shall be paid into the Superannuation Account, without further
appropriation than this section, such sum or sums as may in the opinion of Cabinet
be required to provide a fund sufficient to provide for the payments under this
Act.
(3) Money from the Superannuation Account may be invested in such manner as Cabinet sees fit having regard to the need to ensure that the investment is secure at all times.
(4) The Superannuation Account shall be treated in all respects as if it were public money for the purposes of annual accounts and auditing.

4 Contributions by Members

(1) As from 1 April 1984 there shall be deducted from the salary of every
Member a superannuation contribution at the rate of 10 per cent of the basic salary
of a Member.
(2) A Member may elect, if he so wishes, to contribute a greater amount
from his salary.
152 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

5 Subsidy from Niue Government Account

The Cabinet shall pay out of the Niue Government Account without further
appropriation than this section into the Superannuation Account a subsidy in
respect of each member at a rate of 10 per cent of the basic salary of a Member for
each Member.

6 Retiring allowance

(1) Every Member who ceases to hold office as a Member shall be entitled
to either –
(a) The refund in full to him of his own contributions together with the interest that has been earned on those contributions; or
(b) A retiring allowance purchased by the Superannuation Account on
his behalf using the total of the Members’ own contributions,
together with the subsidy by the Government for that Member, and
the interest that has been earned.
(2) A Member who ceases to hold office in the Assembly may if he so wishes
defer indefinitely making a decision under subsection (1) in which case his own
contributions and the Government subsidy for the period that he was a Member
shall remain in the Superannuation Account and shall continue to earn interest.
(3) Where a Member who has ceased to hold office in the Assembly is
subsequently re-elected to the Assembly all entitlements shall come to an end
unless and until that person again ceases to be a Member of the Assembly at which
time all of his periods of time in office shall be aggregated for the purposes of
ascertaining his entitlement under subsection (1).

7 Death of a Member

(1) In the event of the death of a Member the spouse of that Member shall
be entitled to either –
(a) A refund in full of the contributions made by the deceased Member
together with the interest that had been earned on those
contributions; or
(b) (i) An allowance equivalent to 50 per cent of the retiring allowance
that the deceased Member would have been entitled to had he
ceased to be a Member immediately prior to his death;
(ii) Such allowance shall cease upon the remarrriage of the spouse.
(2) The allowance payable under this section shall be payable on and from
the day following the date of death of the Member.

8 [Spent]

9 Provision for payment

(1) Any allowances and other money payable under this Act shall be paid
out of the Superannuation Account without further appropriation than this Act.
(2) Where in any year the money in the Superannuation Account is
insufficient to meet all payments required to be made, Cabinet may, without further
appropriation than this section make an advance from the Niue Government
Account sufficient to meet the deficiency.
153

ATOMIC ENERGY ACT 1945

1945/41 (NZ) – 7 December 1945

1

Short title

10

Cabinet may mine

2

Interpretation

11

[Repealed]

3

[Repealed]

12

No person to possess fissionable substances

4

Notification of discovery

13

Experimental work

4A

Grant of rewards

14

Restriction on trading

4B

Grants to assist

15

Entry on land and premises

5

Cabinet may control mining

16

Granting of consents

6

Disposition of prescribed substances

17

Service of notices

7

Importation of prescribed substances

18

Offences

8

Uranium to be property of Crown

19

Regulations

9

No compensation for uranium

To make provision for the control in Niue of the means of producing atomic energy and for that purpose to provide for the control of the mining and treatment of the ores of uranium and other elements which may be used for the production of atomic energy, and to provide for the vesting of such substances in the Crown

1 Short title

This is the Atomic Energy Act 1945.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“atomic energy” means the energy released from atomic nuclei as a result
of any process, including the fission process; but does not include energy
released in any process of natural transmutation or radioactive decay
which is not accelerated or influenced by external means;
“minerals” means any mineral, mineral substance, or metal; and includes
precious metals, precious stones, and includes any prescribed substance;
“mining” means mining operations, and includes prospecting;
“mining operations” means operations in connection with mining for any
mineral, and includes –
(a) The removal of overburden by mechanical or other means, and the
stacking, deposit, storage and treatment of any substance considered
to contain any mineral;
(b) The deposit or discharge of any mineral, material, debris, tailings,
refuse, or waste-water produced from, or consequent on, any such
operations or purposes;
154 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) The erection, maintenance, and use of plant and machinery, and the construction or use of roads, races, dams, railways, channels, batteries, buildings, dwellings, and other works connected with such operations or purposes; and
(d) The lawful use of land , water, pools and natural depositories of water (whether containing water or not) and the doing of all lawful acts incident or conducive to such operations;
“prescribed substance” means uranium, thorium, plutonium, neptunium, or any of their respective compounds, or any such other substance as Cabinet may prescribe, being a substance which in his opinion is or may be used for the production of atomic energy or research into matters connected therewith;
“uranium” includes thorium and all natural substances, chemical compounds, and physical combinations of uranium or thorium.

3 [Repealed by 2004/270]

4 Notification of discovery

Every person has discovered that any prescribed substance occurs at any
place in Niue shall, within 3 months after making the discovery, whichever is the
later, report the discovery by written notice (which shall specify the place where
the discovery took place and the date of the discovery) to the Secretary to the
Government.

4A Grant of rewards

(1) The Cabinet may, out of money appropriated by the Assembly for the
purpose, make such grants as the Cabinet thinks fit for the purpose of rewarding
any person discovering any prescribed substance.
(2) Any application for a grant under this section shall be made in writing
to the Secretary to the Government.
(3) Where, in the opinion of the Cabinet, any deposit containing any
prescribed substance has no immediate commercial value but, because of geological
interest, is sufficient to justify further prospecting, Cabinet may make a grant under
this section, not exceeding $400, to the person discovering the deposit.
(4) Where, in the opinion of the Cabinet of Ministers of Niue, any deposit
containing any prescribed substance is sufficient to have a potential value, the
Cabinet may make a grant under this section not exceeding $2,000, to the person
discovering the deposit.
(5) (a) Where, in the opinion of the Cabinet, any deposit containing any
prescribed substance will produce 25 tons or more of uranium oxide,
the Cabinet may make a grant under this section of $2,000, increased
at the rate of $800 for each 5 tons in excess of 25 tons of uranium
oxide which it is estimated that the deposit will produce, to the
person discovering the deposit.
(b) That the total of any grant under this subsection in respect of any
one discovery shall not exceed $50,000.
(6) Payment of any grant under this section may be made in one amount
or by instalments payable at such times as the Cabinet determines.
(7) Where 2 or more persons, either jointly or severally, make application
under this section for a grant in respect of the same discovery of a deposit
containing any prescribed substance, the Cabinet may direct that the grant, if
payable under this section, shall be paid to one applicant only or that it shall be

Atomic Energy Act 1945 155

apportioned between such of the applicants and in such proportions as the Cabinet thinks fit.
(8) Any application for a grant under this section may be granted or refused in the absolute discretion of the Cabinet and, subject to this section, the amount of any such grant shall be in the absolute discretion of the Cabinet.
(9) Any grant made under this section shall be exempt from income tax.

4B Grants to assist

(1) The Cabinet may, out of money appropriated by the Assembly for the
purpose make such grants as the Cabinet thinks fit for the purpose of assisting
any person prospecting for or producing any prescribed substance.
(2) Any grant under this section may be by way of cash payment, loan,
subsidy, or otherwise and may be made either unconditionally or subject to such
conditions as the Cabinet thinks fit.
(3) Any application for a grant under this section shall be made in writing
to the Secretary to the Government.
(4) Payment of any grant under this section may be made in one amount
or by instalments payable at such times as the Cabinet determines.
(5) The Cabinet may for the purposes of this section, in the name and on
behalf of Her Majesty, make and enforce such agreements, and execute such
instruments, as the Cabinet thinks fit.

5 Cabinet may control mining

(1) If the Cabinet is satisfied that any person is mining or is about to mine
any prescribed substance or is engaged or about to engage in carrying out any
physical, chemical, or metallurgical process as a result of which, in the opinion of
the Cabinet, any prescribed substance may reasonably be expected to be isolated
or extracted, the Cabinet may, by notice in writing given to that person, require
him in conducting the mining operations or in carrying out any process as aforesaid
to comply with and observe such terms and conditions as the Cabinet may in the
notice think fit to impose.
(2) Without prejudice to the generality of subsection (1), the Cabinet may
require that the mining operations shall be so conducted, or that such process for
treatment and concentration shall be used, as will provide for or facilitate the
extraction, isolation or concentration of the prescribed substance.

6 Disposition of prescribed substances

(1) All minerals, concentrates, or other materials containing any prescribed
substance which are extracted, isolated, or concentrated by any person shall only
be disposed of with the prior written consent of the Cabinet and subject to such
conditions as the Cabinet shall impose.
(2) The Cabinet may serve notice on any person who has produced any
mineral, concentrate, or other material containing any prescribed substance that
the Cabinet proposes to acquire, on behalf of Her Majesty, the mineral, concentrate
or other material, and upon the service of the notice and the payment of purchase
price under this section, the mineral, concentrate, or material shall become the
property of the Crown and shall be delivered to the Cabinet or as it shall direct.
(3) There shall be payable out of money appropriated by the Assembly for
the purpose in respect of the acquisition of any substance under this section a
sum equal to the price which the owner of it might reasonably have been expected
to obtain upon a sale of it effected by him immediately before the date of the
service of the notice referred to in subsection (2).
156 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

7 Importation of prescribed substances

(1) Subject to subsection (2), no person shall, without the prior written
consent of the Cabinet, import any prescribed substance.
(2) Samples of any minerals containing any prescribed substance may be
imported without the consent of the Cabinet if the weight of those samples does
not exceed 5 pounds.

8 Uranium to be property of Crown

(1) (a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Act or in any
Crown grant, certificate of title, lease, or other instrument of title,
all uranium existing in its natural condition on or below the surface
of any land within the territorial limits of Niue, whether the land
has been alienated from the Crown or not, is hereby declared to be
the property of the Crown.
(b) Nothing in this subsection or in section 9 shall be deemed to affect
the right of any person to receive payment in respect of any mineral,
concentrate, or other material containing any prescribed substance
mined or produced by that person under this Act.
(2) All alienations of land from the Crown, whether by way of sale or lease
or otherwise, shall be deemed to be made subject to the reservation of all uranium
existing in its natural condition on or below the surface of the land, and subject to
this Act.

9 No compensation for uranium

Compensation shall not be payable under any Acts in respect of any
uranium existing in its natural condition on or below the surface of any land.

10 Cabinet may mine

(1) The Cabinet may mine for any mineral containing any prescribed
substance and carry on such processes or operations as the Cabinet thinks fit for
the concentration, isolation, extraction and chemical purification of any prescribed
substance.
(2) For the purposes of this section the provisions of any enactment relating
to the application for, holding, purchase, or other acquisition of any licence
authorising the prospecting for or mining of any prescribed substance shall apply
to the Cabinet in all respects as they apply to any other person.

11 [Repealed 1976/4/26]

12 No person to possess fissionable substances

(1) No person shall, without the prior written consent of the Cabinet, import
or have in his possession or control any plutonium or other substance from which
atomic energy may be produced more readily than from uranium of natural isotope
composition.
(2) No person shall, without the prior written consent of the Cabinet,
import, construct, have in his possession or control, or operate any machine, atomic
pile, or apparatus which may be capable of producing atomic energy or which the
Cabinet has by notice in the Gazette for the purpose of this section declared to be
an essential part of any such machine, pile, or apparatus.
(3) No person shall, without the prior written consent of the Cabinet
import, manufacture, or have in his possession or control any material or substance
which that Cabinet has by notice in the Gazette for the purposes of this section
declared to be essential to any process for the production of atomic energy.

Atomic Energy Act 1945 157

13 Experimental work

(1) Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Act, uranium and
thorium of natural isotope composition of an amount not exceeding the appropriate
amount mentioned in subsection (2) may be possessed and used for the purpose
of instruction and of investigation as to the properties and effects of radioactive
and like radiations at any university in Niue, at any school providing secondary
instruction, and at any laboratory under the control of a Department of State.
(2) (a) The amount of uranium and of thorium that may be possessed and
used as provided in subsection (1) shall be one pound each of
uranium and of thorium, calculated by metal content in the case of
a school providing secondary instruction, and 20 pounds each of
uranium and of thorium, calculated by metal content, in any other
case.
(b) Cabinet may by notice in the Gazette increase or reduce the amounts
that may be possessed and used as aforesaid.
(3) Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this Act any university in
Niue and any laboratory under the control of a Department of State, may import,
purchase, construct, have possession and control of, and operate any machine,
pile, or apparatus capable of the production of atomic energy at a rate not exceeding
1000 watts, or at such other rate and under such conditions as may be fixed by the
Cabinet by notice in the Gazette, and may retain and use for experimental purposes
the products produced.

14 Restriction on trading

No person shall, without the prior written consent of the Cabinet, export
or sell or otherwise dispose of any isotope of uranium, or any plutonium or other
substance from which atomic energy may be more readily obtained than from
uranium of natural isotope composition, except to the Crown.

15 Entry on land and premises

(1) It is hereby declared that any person authorised either specially or
generally by the Cabinet may enter on any premises on which any mining
operations are carried on or on which the person or officer so authorised has
reasonable grounds to suspect that there may be found minerals, concentrates, or
other materials which have been mined, extracted, isolated, or concentrated and
which contain any prescribed substance, for the purpose of ascertaining whether
or not there is any prescribed substance on the premises or in any minerals,
concentrates, or other materials, and for that purpose the person or officer so
authorised may make observations and tests and may extract and remove samples
for further testing.
(2) Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine
not exceeding 1 penalty unit or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months
who wilfully obstructs or interferes with any person exercising or attempting to
exercise his powers under this section.

16 Granting of consents

In granting any consent or imposing any requirement under this Act the
Cabinet may impose such conditions as the Cabinet thinks fit.
158 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

17 Service of notices

(1) Any notice required to be given to any person for the purposes of this
Act may be given by causing it to be delivered to that person, or to be left at his
usual or last known place of abode or business or at the address specified by him
in any application or other document received from him for the purposes of this
Act, or to be posted in a letter addressed to him at that place of abode or business
or at that address.
(2) If any such notice is sent to any person by registered letter, it shall be
deemed to have been delivered to him when it would have been delivered in the
ordinary course of post, and in proving the delivery it shall be sufficient to prove
that the letter was properly addressed and posted.

18 Offences

Any person who fails to comply with, or contravenes, any provision,
prohibition, condition, or requirement contained in or imposed under this Act
commits an offence and, where no specific penalty is elsewhere provided, shall be
liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 6 months or to both such fine and such imprisonment.

19 Regulations

The Cabinet may make all such regulations as may in its opinion be
necessary or expedient for giving full effect to this Act and for its due
administration.
159

AVIATION CRIMES ACT 1973

1973/82 – 24 September 1973

1

Short title and commencement

9

Application of sections 3, 4 and 5

2

Interpretation

10

Powers of aircraft commander

3

Hijacking

11

Arrest of persons delivered to Police

4

Offences in connection with hijacking

12

Cabinet’s consent required for prosecution

5

Other offences relating to aircraft

13

Aircraft in military, customs, or police

5A Offences relating to airports

service

6

[Spent]

14

Joint registration of aircraft

7

Offences deemed to be included in 15

Other Acts not affected

extradition treaties

8

Surrender of offenders

To give effect to the provisions of the Hague Convention for the Convention for the Suppression of Unlawful Seizure of Aircraft, the Montreal Convention for the Suppression of Unlawful Acts against the Safety of Civil Aviation, and the Tokyo Convention on Offence and Certain Other Acts Committed on Board Aircraft, and for matters incidental thereto

1 Short title and commencement

(1) This is the Aviation Crimes Act 1973.
(2) Sections 7, 8, 10 and 11 shall come into force on a date to be fixed by the
Cabinet by notice in the Gazette. Different dates may be so fixed in respect of
different sections.
(3) Except as provided in subsection (2), this Act shall come into force on
the date of its passing.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“aircraft” means a machine that can derive support in the atmosphere from
the reactions of the air otherwise than by the reactions of the air against
the surface of the earth;
“commander”, in relation to an aircraft, means the pilot for the time being
in lawful command of the aircraft;
“military service” includes naval and air force service; and a certificate by
the Minister that any aircraft is or is not used in military service for the
purposes of this Act shall be conclusive evidence of the fact certified;
”Niue” includes the territorial sea of Niue;
“Niue aircraft” means an aircraft registered in Niue under the Civil Aviation
Act 1999;
“The Hague Convention” means the Convention for the Suppression of
Unlawful Seizure of Aircraft, done at the Hague on 16 December 1970
“The Montreal Convention” means the Convention for the Suppression of
160 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
Unlawful Acts against the Safety of Civil Aviation, done at Montreal on 23 September 1971;
“The Tokyo Convention” means the Convention on Offences and Certain
Other Acts Committed on Board Aircraft, done at Tokyo on 14
September 1973.
(2) For the purposes of this Act, a person shall be deemed ordinarily
resident in Niue of –
(a) His home is in Niue; or
(b) He is residing in Niue with the intention of establishing his home
in it, or with the intention of residing in Niue indefinitely, he is
outside Niue but has an intention to return to establish his home in
it or to reside in Niue indefinitely.
(3) For the purposes of this Act, an aircraft is in flight from the time when
all its external doors are closed after embarkation until the time when any external
door is opened for disembarkation:
Provided that in the case of a forced landing an aircraft is in flight until the
time when the competent authorities of the country in which the forced landing
takes place, or, in the case of a forced landing in a place that is not within the
territorial limits of any country, the competent authorities of any country, assume
responsibility for the aircraft and for persons and property on board the aircraft.
(4) For the purposes of this Act, an aircraft is in service from the time when
pre-flight preparation of the aircraft by ground personnel or by the aircraft’s crew
begins for a specific flight until either –
(a) The flight is cancelled; or
(b) 24 hours after the aircraft, having commenced the flight, lands; or
(c) The aircraft, having commenced the flight, makes a forced landing
and any competent authorities referred to in subsection (3) assume
responsibility for the aircraft and for persons and property on board
the aircraft; or
(d) The aircraft, having commenced the flight, ceases to be in flight –
whichever is the latest.

3 Hijacking

Everyone commits the crime of hijacking and is liable on conviction to
imprisonment for life, who, while on board an aircraft in flight, whether in or
outside Niue, unlawfully, by force or by threat of force or by any form of
intimidation, seizes or exercises control, or attempts to seize or exercise control, of
that aircraft.

4 Offences in connection with hijacking

(1) Everyone who, while on board an aircraft in flight outside Niue, does
or omits anything which, if done or omitted by that person in Niue, would be an
offence, commits that offence if the act or omission occurred in connection with
the offence of hijacking.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1) an act or omission by
any person shall be deemed to occur in connection with the offence of hijacking if
it was done or omitted with intent –
(a) To commit or facilitate the commission of the offence of hijacking;
or
(b) To avoid the detection of himself or of any other person in the
commission of the offence or hijacking; or
(c) To avoid the arrest or facilitate the flight of himself or of any other
person upon the commission of the offence of hijack.

Aviation Crimes Act 1973

161

5 Other offences relating to aircraft

Everyone commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 14 years, who, whether in or outside Niue –
(a) On board on aircraft in flight, commits an assault which is likely to
endanger the safety of the aircraft; or
(b) Destroys an aircraft in service; or
(c) Causes damage to an aircraft in service which renders the aircraft
incapable of flight or which is likely to endanger the safety of the
aircraft in flight; or
(d) Places or causes to be placed on an aircraft in service anything which
is likely to destroy the aircraft, or to cause damage to the aircraft
which will render it incapable of flight, or which is likely to endanger
the safety of the aircraft in flight; or
(e) Destroys, damages, or interference with the operation of any air-
navigation facility used in international air navigation, or in air
navigation between Niue and any place outside Niue, where the
destruction, damage, or interference is likely to endanger the safety
of an aircraft in flight; or
(f) Endangers the safety of an aircraft in flight by communicating to
any other person any information which the persons supplying the
information knows to be false.

5A Offences relating to airports

Every person commits an offence, and shall be liable on conviction to a
term of imprisonment not exceeding 14 years who, using any device, substance or
weapon –
(a) Performs any act of violence against a person at an airport serving international civil aviation which causes or is likely to cause serious injury or death; or
(b) Destroys or seriously damages the facilities of an airport serving international civil aviation, or any aircraft not in service located at such airport, or disrupts the services of the airport;
if such act endangers or is likely to endanger safety at that airport.

6 [Spent]

7 Offences deemed to be included in extradition treaties

(1) (a) For the purposes of the Extradition Act, the offence of hijacking
(including aiding, abetting, inciting, counselling, or procuring any
person to commit that offence, inciting, counselling, or attempting
to procure any person to commit that offence when it is not in fact
committed, and being an accessory after the fact to that offence)
shall, if not already described in the treaty, be deemed to be an
offence described in any extradition treaty extending to Niue
concluded before the commencement of this section and for the
time being in force between Niue and any foreign country which is
a party to the Hague Convention.
(b) A certificate given under the hand of the Minister that any foreign
country is a party as aforesaid shall be sufficient evidence of that
fact.
162

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

(2) (a) For the purposes of the Extradition Act 1965 of the New Zealand Parliament and any Order in Council made under section 3 of that Act or referred to in section 21 of that Act, each offence described in section 5 of this Act (including attempting to commit that offence, aiding, abetting, inciting, counselling, or procuring any person to commit that offence, inciting, counselling or attempting to procure any person to commit that offence when it is not in fact committed, and being an accessory after the fact to that offence) shall be deemed to be an offence described in any extradition treaty extending to Niue, concluded before the commencement of this section and for the time being in force between Niue and any foreign country which is a party to the Montreal Convention.
(b) A certificate given under the hand of the Minister that any foreign country is a party as aforesaid shall be sufficient evidence of that fact.
(3) Where, under subsection (1) or under (2), any offence is deemed to be an offence described in an extradition treaty extending to Niue, a person whose surrender is sought under the Extradition Act 1965 of the New Zealand Parliament in respect of an act or omission which amounts to that offence shall be liable to be surrendered in accordance with that Act, whether the act or omission occurred before or after the date on which the crime was deemed to be an offence described in the extradition treaty.
(4) For the purposes of this section, “foreign country” includes any territory for whose international relations the Government of a foreign country is responsible and to which the extradition treaty and the Hague Convention or, as the case may be, the Montreal Convention extends.

8 Surrender of offenders

(1) (a) Where the surrender of a person is sought under either the
Extradition Act 1965 of the New Zealand Parliament or the Fugitive
Offenders Act 1881 of the United Kingdom Parliament in respect of
any act or omission which amounts to the offence of hijacking or to
any offence described in section 5 or section 5A (including
attempting to commit any of the offences so described, siding,
abetting, inciting, counselling, or procuring any person to commit
the offence of hijacking or any of the offences so described, inciting,
counselling, or attempting to procure any person to commit the
offence of hijacking or any of the offences so described when it is
not in fact committed, and being an accessory after the fact to the
offences of hijacking or any of the offences so described), and for
which the person whose surrender is sought could be tried and
punished in the country seeking surrender, being a country which
is a party to the Hague Convention or the Montreal Convention, as
the case may require, that act or omission shall be deemed to have
been committed within the jurisdiction of that country
notwithstanding that it was committed outside the territory of that
country.
(b) A certificate given under the hand of the Minister that a country is
party to either Convention shall be sufficient evidence of that fact.
(2) For the purposes of this section, “country” includes any territory for
whose international relations the Government of a country is responsible and to which the extradition treaty (if any) and the Hague Convention or, as the case may be, the Montreal Convention, extends.

Aviation Crimes Act 1973

163

9 Application of sections 3, 4 and 5

(1) Nothing in section 3 or 4 shall apply if both the place of take-off and
the place of actual landing of the aircraft (not being a Niuean aircraft) are in the
territory of the country in which the aircraft is registered, or, in the case of an
aircraft that is subject to joint or international registration, in the territory of one
of the countries having an interest in the aircraft, unless –
(a) The alleged offender is a person ordinarily resident in Niue;
(b) The act or omission occurred in Niue; or
(c) The alleged offender is present in Niue.
(2) Nothing in section 5(a), (b), (c), (d) or (f) shall apply if both the place of
take-off and the place of actual or intended landing of the aircraft (not being a
Niuean aircraft) are in the territory of a country in which the aircraft is registered,
or, in the case of an aircraft that is subject to joint or international registration, in
the territory of one of the countries having an interest in the aircraft, unless –
(a) The alleged offender is a person ordinarily resident in Niue;
(b) The act or omission occurred in Niue; or
(c) The alleged offender is present in Niue.
(3) Nothing in section 3 or section 4 or section 5 (a)-(d) shall apply to aircraft
used in military, customs, or police service (not being aircraft used for the purposes
of any of the Armed Forces of New Zealand operating in Niue or of the Niue
Customs or of the Niue Police), unless –
(a) The alleged offender is a person ordinarily resident in Niue;
(b) The set or omission occurred in Niue.

10 Powers of aircraft commander

(1) If the commander of an aircraft in flight, wherever that aircraft may be,
has reasonable grounds to believe that any person on board the aircraft has done
or is about to do on board the aircraft –
(a) Anything which is an offence under the law of this country in which
the aircraft is registered or under the law of Niue (not being a law
of a political nature or a law based on racial or religious
discrimination); or
(b) Anything (whether an offence or not) which jeopardises or may
jeopardise –
(i) the safety of the aircraft or of persons or property on board the
aircraft; or
(ii) good order and discipline on board the aircraft –
the commander may take with respect to that person such reasonable measures,
including restraint, as may be necessary –
(c) To protect the safety of the aircraft or of persons or property on
board the aircraft; or
(d) To maintain good order and discipline on board the aircraft;
(e) To enable the commander to disembark or deliver that person under
subsection (4) or (5).
(2) (a) Any member of the crew of an aircraft and any other person on
board the aircraft may, at the request or with the authority of the
commander of the aircraft and any member of the crew shall if so
required by the commander, assist in restraining any person whom
the commander is entitled under subsection (1) to restrain.
164 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Any member of the crew and any other person on board the aircraft may, without the commander ’s authority take with respect to any person on board the aircraft such reasonable measures, including restraint, as he has reasonable grounds to believe are immediately necessary to protect the safety of the aircraft or of persons or property on board the aircraft.
(3) Any restraint imposed on any person on board an aircraft under the powers conferred by subsection (1) or (2) shall not be continued after the aircraft ceases to be in flight, unless the commander of the aircraft notifies the appropriate authorities of the country or territory in which the aircraft ceases to be in flight, either before or as soon as reasonably practicable after that time, that a person on board is under restraint and of the reasons for such restraint, but, provided that notification has been given, restraint may be continued –
(a) For any period (including the period of any further flight) between that time and the first occasion thereafter on which the commander is able with the requisite consent of the appropriate authorities to disembark or deliver the person under restraint in accordance with subsection (4) or (5); or
(b) If the person under restraint agrees to continue his journey under restraint on board that aircraft.
(4) If the commander of an aircraft has reasonable grounds to believe that
a person on board the aircraft has done or is about to do on board the aircraft
anything (whether an offence or not) which jeopardises or may jeopardise –
(a) The safety of the aircraft or of persons or property on board the
aircraft; or
(b) Good order and discipline on board the aircraft –
he may, if he considers it necessary to do so in order to protect the safety of the
aircraft, disembark that person in any country or territory in which the aircraft
may be.
(5) If the commander of an aircraft has reasonable grounds to believe that
any person on board the aircraft has done on board the aircraft anything which in
the commander ’s opinion is a serious offence under the law of the country in
which the aircraft is registered or under the law of Niue, he may deliver that
person –
(a) In Niue, to any member of the Niue Police; or
(b) In any country which is a party to the Tokyo Convention,
to any person exercising functions corresponding to those of a member of the
Niue Police.
(6) If the commander of an aircraft disembarks any person under subsection
(4) in the case of a Niuean aircraft, in any country, or, in the case of any other
aircraft, in Niue, he shall report the fact of, and the reasons for, that disembarkation
to an appropriate authority in the country or territory of disembarkation (being,
in Niue, a member of the Niue Police).
(7) If the commander of an aircraft intends to deliver any person under
subsection (5) in Niue, or, in the case of a Niuean aircraft, in any country which is
a party to the Tokyo Convention, he shall, before or as soon as practicable after
landing, give notification of his intention and of the reasons for his intention to an
appropriate authority in that country, or, in the case of a person to be delivered in
Niue, to a member of the Niue Police.
(8) Any commander of an aircraft who without reasonable cause fails to
comply with the requirements of subsection (6) or (7) is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

Aviation Crimes Act 1973

165
(9) A person who in good faith imposes reasonable measures, including restraint, on another person under this section is not guilty of an offence and is not liable to any civil proceedings in respect of those measures.

11 Arrest of persons delivered to Police

(1) Any constable shall accept delivery of a person whom the commander
of an aircraft seeks to deliver to him under section 10 (5) if he has reasonable
grounds to support that person of having done or omitted on board that aircraft
anything that is an offence against this Act, or any other Act, or any enactment in
force in Niue.
(2) Where any constable accepts delivery of a person under subsection (1),
he shall forthwith arrest that person.

12 Cabinet’s consent required for prosecution

(1) No proceedings for the trial and punishment or any person charged
with a crime against sections 3-5 shall be instituted in the High Court except with
the consent of the Cabinet.
(2) A person charged with any such offence may be arrested, or a warrant
for his arrest may be issued and executed, and he may be remanded in custody or
on bail, notwithstanding that the consent of the Cabinet to the institution of a
prosecution for the offence has not been obtained, but no further proceedings
shall be taken until that consent has been obtained.

13 Aircraft in military, customs, or police service

Nothing in sections 10 and 11 shall apply to aircraft used in the military,
customs or police service of any country, or of Niue, or of any territory for whose
international relations the Government of a country is responsible.

14 Joint registration of aircraft

Where an aircraft is subject to joint international registration, it shall be
deemed for the purposes of this Act to be registered in the country which, according
to the records of the International Civil Aviation Organisation, is the country of
registration.

15 Other Acts not affected

Nothing in this Act shall be construed to limit or affect the operation of the
Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985 or of Parts 5, 6 or 8 of the Niue Act 1996.

166 Niue Laws 2006 Vall

167

BILLS OF EXCHANGE ACT 1908

1908/15 (NZ) – 4 August 1908

1

Short title

2

Interpretation

PART 1

BILLS OF EXCHANGE

Forms and Interpretations

3

“Bill of exchange” defined

4

Inland and foreign bills

5

How bills may be drawn

6

Address to drawee

7

Certainty required as to payee

8

What bills are negotiable

9

Sum payable

10

Bill payable on demand

11

Bill payable at a future time

12

Omission of date in bill payable after date

13

Antedating and postdating

14

Computation of time of payment

15

Referee in case of need

16

Optional stipulations by drawer or indorser

17

Definition and requisites of acceptance

18

Time for acceptance

19

General and qualified acceptances

20

Inchoate instruments

21

Delivery

Capacity and Authority of Parties

22

Capacity of parties

23

Signature essential to liability

24

Forged or unauthorised signature

25

Signature by procuration

26

Person signing as agent or representative

The Consideration for a Bill

27

Value and holder for value

28

Accommodation party

29

Holder in due course

30

Presumption of value and good faith

Negotiation of Bills

31

Negotiation of bill

32

Requisition of a valid indorsement

33

Conditional indorsement

34

Indorsement in blank, and special

indorsement

35

Restrictive indorsement

168 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

66

Liability of acceptor for honour

81

Effect of the words “Not negotiable”

67

Presentation to acceptor for honour

82

[Repealed]

68

Payment for honour supra protest

83

Branch banks deemed independent banks

for certain purposes

Lost Bills

69

Holder ’s right to duplicate of lost bill

PART 3

70

Action on lost bill

PROMISSORY NOTES

84

“Promissory note” defined

Bill in a Set 85 Delivery necessary

71

Rules as to sets

86

Joint and several notes

87

Note payable on demand

Conflict of Laws 88 Presentment of note for payment

72

Law governing contracts contained in a bill

89

Liability of maker

90

Application of Part 1 to notes

PART 2

CHEQUES ON A BANK

PART 4

73

“Cheques” defined

MISCELLANEOUS

74

Presentment of cheques for payment

91

Good faith

75

Revocation of banker ’s authority

92

Signature

93

Computation of time

Crossed Cheques 94 When noting equivalent to protest

76

General and special crossings defined

95

Protest when notary not accessible

77

Crossing by drawer or after issue

96

Bill drawn at sight to be deemed a bill

78

Crossing to be deemed a material part of

payable on demand

cheque

97

[Repealed]

79

Duties of banker as to crossed cheques

98

Saving

80

Protection to banker and drawer where

cheque is crossed SCHEDULES

To consolidate certain enactments relating to bills of exchange

1 Short title

(1) This is the Bills of Exchange Act 1908.
(2) [Spent]
(3) This Act is divided into Parts, as follows:
Part 1 – Bills of Exchange
Part 2 – Cheques on a Bank
Part 3 – Promissory Notes
Part 4 – Miscellaneous.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“acceptance” means an acceptance completed by delivery or notice;
“action” includes counterclaim and set-off;
“banker” includes a body of persons, whether incorporated or not, who
carry on the business of banking;
“bankrupt” includes any person whose estate is vested in a trustee or
assignee under the law for the time being in force relating to bankruptcy;
“bearer” means the person in possession of a bill or note payable to bearer;
“bill” means bill of exchange, and “note” means promissory note;
“delivery” means transfer of possession, actual or constructive, from one
person to another;

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

169
“holder” means the payee or indorsee of a bill or note who is in possession of it, or the bearer of it;
“indorsement” means an indorsement completed by delivery;
“issue” means the first delivery of a bill or note, complete in form, to a
person who takes it as a holder;
“non-business day” means every day on which bank premises are not open
for business;
“value” means valuable consideration.
PART 1
BILLS OF EXCHANGE

Forms and Interpretation

3 “Bill of exchange” defined

(1) A bill of exchange is an unconditional order in writing, addressed by
one person to another, signed by the person giving it, requiring the person to
whom it is addressed to pay on demand, or at a fixed or determinable future time,
a sum certain in money to or to the order of a specified person, or to bearer.
(2) An instrument that does not comply with these conditions, or that orders
any act to be done in addition to the payment of money, is not a bill of exchange.
(3) An order to pay out of a particular fund is not unconditional within
the meaning of this section; but an unqualified order to pay, coupled with (a) an
indication of a particular fund out of which the drawee is to reimburse himself or
a particular account to be debited with the amount, or (b) a statement of the
transaction giving rise to the bill, is unconditional.
(4) A bill is not invalid by reason that –
(a) It is not dated;
(b) It does not specify the value given, or that any value has been give;
(c) It does not specify the place where it is drawn or the place where it
is payable.

4 Inland and foreign bills

(1) An “inland bill” is a bill that is, or on the face of it purports to be –
(a) Both drawn and payable in any country of the Realm of New
Zealand or the Commonwealth of Australia or any state or territory
of Australia;
(b) Drawn in any country of the Realm of New Zealand or the
Commonwealth of Australia or any state or territory of Australia
upon some person resident therein.
Any other bill is a “foreign bill”.
(2) Unless the contrary appears on the face of the bill the holder may treat
it as an inland bill.

5 How bills may be drawn

(1) A bill may be drawn payable to or to the order of the drawer; or it may
be drawn payable to or to the order of the drawee.
(2) Where in a bill drawer and drawee are the same person, or where the
drawee is a fictitious person or a person not having capacity to contract, the holder
may treat the instrument, at his option, either as a bill of exchange or as a
promissory note.
170 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

6 Address to drawee

(1) The drawee must be named or otherwise indicated in a bill with
reasonable certainty.
(2) A bill may be addressed to 2 or more drawees, whether they are partners
or not; but an order addressed to 2 drawees in the alternative, or to 2 or more
drawees in succession, is not a bill of exchange.

7 Certainty required as to payee

(1) Where a bill is not payable to bearer, the payee must be named or
otherwise indicated therein with reasonable certainty.
(2) A bill may be made payable –
(a) To 2 or more payees jointly; or
(b) In the alternative to one or 2, or one or some of several payees; or
(c) To the holder of an office for the time being.
(3) Where the payee is a fictitious or non-existing person the bill may be
treated as payable to bearer.

8 What bills are negotiable

(1) Where a bill contains words prohibiting transfer, or indicating an
intention that it is not transferable, it is valid as between the parties to it, but is not
negotiable.
(2) A negotiable bill may be payable either to order or to bearer.
(3) A bill is payable to bearer if it is expressed to be so payable, or if the
only or the last indorsement thereon is an indorsement in blank.
(4) A bill is payable to order if it is expressed to be so payable, or if it is
expressed to be payable to a particular person, and does not contain words
prohibiting transfer or indicating an intention that it is not transferable.
(5) Where a bill, either originally or by indorsement, is expressed to be
payable to the order of a specified person, and not to him or his order, it is
nevertheless payable to him or his order at his option.

9 Sum payable

(1) The sum payable by a bill is a sum certain, within the meaning of this
Act, although it is required to be paid –
(a) With interest;
(b) By stated instalments;
(c) By stated instalments, with a provision that upon default in payment
of any instalment the whole shall become due;
(d) According to an indicated rate of exchange, or according to a rate
of exchange to be ascertained as directed by the bill.
(2) Where the sum payable is expressed in words and also in figures, and
there is a discrepancy between the 2, the sum denoted by the words is the amount
payable.
(3) Where a bill is expressed to be payable with interest, unless the
instrument provides otherwise, interest runs from the date of the bill, and, if the
bill is undated, from its issue.

10 Bill payable on demand

(1) A bill is payable on demand –
(a) If it is expressed to be payable on demand, or at sight, or on
presentation; or
(b) If no time for payment is expressed therein.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

171
(2) Where a bill is accepted or indorsed when it is overdue, it shall, as regards the acceptor who so accepts, or any indorser who so indorses it, be deemed a bill payable on demand.

11 Bill payable at a future time

(1) A bill is payable at a determinable future time within the meaning of
this Act if it is expressed to be payable –
(a) At a fixed period after date or sight;
(b) On or at a fixed period after the occurrence of a specified event that
is certain to happen, though the time of happening may be uncertain.
(2) An instrument expressed to be payable on a contingency is not a bill,
and the happening of the event does not cure the defect.

12 Omission of date in bill payable after date

Where a bill expressed to be payable at a fixed period after date is issued
undated, or where the acceptance of a bill payable at a fixed period after sight is
undated, any holder may insert therein the true date of issue or acceptance, and
the bill shall be payable accordingly:
Provided that (a) where the holder in good faith and by mistake inserts a
wrong date, and (b) in every case where a wrong date is inserted, if the bill
subsequently comes into the hands of a holder in due course, it shall not be avoided
by the insertion of a wrong date, but shall operate and be payable as if the date so
inserted had been the true date.

13 Antedating and postdating

(1) Where a bill or an acceptance or any indorsement on a bill is dated, the
date shall, unless the contrary is proved, be deemed to be the true date of the
drawing, acceptance, or indorsement, as the case may be.
(2) A bill is not invalid by reason only that it is undated or postdated, or
that it bears date on a Sunday.

14 Computation of time of payment

Where a bill is not payable on demand, the day on which it falls due is
determined as follows –
(a) Three days (called “days of grace”), are in every case where the bill
itself does not provide otherwise, added to the time of payment as
fixed by the bill, and the bill is due and payable on the last day of
grace;
Provided that when the last day of grace is a non-business day the
bill is due and payable on the next following business day;
(b) Where a bill is payable at a fixed period after date, after sight, or
after the happening of a specified event, the time of payment is
determined by excluding the day from which the time is to begin
to run and by including the day of payment;
(c) Where a bill is payable at a fixed period after sight, the time begins
to run from the date of the acceptance if the bill is accepted, and
from the date of noting or protest if the bill is noted or protested for
non-acceptance or for non-delivery.
172 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

15 Referee in case of need

The drawer of a bill and any indorser may insert in it the name of a person
to whom the holder may resort in case of need – that is to say, in case the bill is
dishonoured by non-acceptance or non-payment. Such person is called the referee
in case of need. It is in the option of the holder to resort to the referee in case of
need or not.

16 Optional stipulations by drawer or indorser

The drawer of a bill, and any indorser, may insert in it an express
stipulation –
(a) Negativing or limiting his own liability to the holder;
(b) Waiving as regards himself some or all of the holder ’s duties.

17 Definition and requisites of acceptance

(1) The acceptance of a bill is the signification by the drawee of his assent
to the order of the drawer.
(2) An acceptance is invalid unless it complies with the following
conditions, namely:
(a) It must be written on the bill and be signed by the drawee; the
mere signature of the drawee without additional words is sufficient;
(b) It must not state that the drawee will perform his promise by any
other means than the payment of money.

18 Time for acceptance

(1) A bill may be accepted –
(a) Before it has been signed by the drawer or while otherwise
incomplete;
(b) When it is overdue, or after it has been dishonoured by a previous
refusal to accept, or by non-payment.
(2) Where a bill payable after sight is dishonoured by non-acceptance, and
the drawee subsequently accepts it, the holder, in the absence of any different
agreement, is entitled to have the bill accepted as on the date of its first presentment
to the drawee for acceptance.

19 General and qualified acceptances

(1) An acceptance is either (a) general, or (b) qualified.
(2) A general acceptance assents without qualification to the order of the
drawer; a qualified acceptance in express terms varies the effect of the bill as drawn.
(3) In particular, an acceptance is qualified which is –
(a) Conditional – which makes payment by the acceptor dependent
on the fulfillment of a condition in it stated;
(b) Partial – an acceptance to pay part only of the amount for which
the bill is drawn;
(c) Local – an acceptance to pay only at a particular specified place.
An acceptance to pay at a particular place is a general acceptance,
unless it expressly states that the bill is to be paid there only and
not elsewhere;
(d) Qualified as to time;
(e) The acceptance of some one or more of the drawees, but not of all.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

173

20 Inchoate instruments

(1) Where a simple signature on a blank stamped paper is delivered by the
signer in order that it may be converted into a bill, it operates as a prima facie authority to fill it up as a complete bill for any amount the stamp will cover, using the signature for that of the drawer, or the acceptor, or an indorser; and in like manner, where a bill is wanting in any material particular, the person in possession of it has a prima facie authority to fill up the omission in any way.
(2) (a) In order that any such instrument when completed may be enforceable against any person who became a party thereto prior to its completion, it must be filled up within a reasonable time, and strictly under the authority given.
(b) Reasonable time for this purpose is a question of fact.
(c) If any such instrument after completion is negotiated to a holder in
due course, it shall be valid and effectual for all purposes in his
hands, and he may enforce it as if it had been filled up within a
reasonable time and strictly under the authority given.

21 Delivery

(1) (a) Every contract on a bill, whether it is the drawer ’s, the acceptor ’s
or an indorser ’s, is incomplete and revocable until delivery of the
instrument in order to give effect to it.
(b) Where an acceptance is written on a bill, and the drawee gives notice
to or according to the directions of the person entitled to the bill
that he has accepted it, the acceptance then becomes complete and
irrevocable.
(2) As between immediate parties, and as regards a remote party other
than the holder in due course, the delivery –
(a) In order to be effectual must be made either by or under the
authority of the party drawing, accepting, or indorsing, as the case
may be;
(b) May be shown to have been conditional, or for a special purpose
only, and not for the purpose of transferring the property in the
bill.
(3) If the bill is in the hands of a holder in due course, a valid delivery of
the bill by all parties prior to him so as to make them liable to him is conclusively
presumed.
(4) Where a bill is no longer in the possession of a party who has signed it
as drawer, acceptor, or indorser, a valid and unconditional delivery by him is
presumed until the contrary is proved.

Capacity and Authority of Parties

22 Capacity of parties

(1) (a) Capacity to incur liability as a party to a bill is co-extensive with
capacity to contract.
(b) Nothing in this section shall enable a corporation to make itself
liable as a drawer, acceptor, or indorser of a bill unless it is competent
to it so to do under the law for the time being in force relating to
corporations.
(2) Where a bill is drawn or indorsed by a minor or corporation, having no
capacity or power to incur liability on a bill, the drawing or indorsement entitles
the holder to receive payment of the bill and to enforce it against any other party
thereto.
174 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

23 Signature essential to liability

(1) No person is liable as drawer, indorser, or acceptor of a bill unless he
has signed it as such.
(2) (a) Where a person signs a bill in a trade or assumed name, he is liable
thereon as if he had signed it in his own name.
(b) The signature of the name of a firm is equivalent to the signature
by the person so signing of the names of all persons liable as partners
in that firm.

24 Forged or unauthorised signature

(1) Subject to this Act, where a signature on a bill is forged, or is placed
thereon without the authority of the person whose signature it purports to be, the
forged or unauthorised signature is wholly inoperative, and no right to retain the
bill or to give a discharge therefor or to enforce payment thereof against any party
to it can be acquired through or under that signature, unless the party against
whom it is sought to retain or enforce payment of the bill is precluded from setting
up the forgery or want of authority.
(2) Nothing in this section shall affect the ratification of an unauthorised
signature not amounting to a forgery.

25 Signature by procuration

A signature by procuration operates as notice that the agent has but a limited
authority to sign, and the principal is bound by such signature only if the agent in
so signing was acting within the actual limits of his authority.

26 Person signing as agent or representative

(1) Where a person signs a bill as drawer, indorser, or acceptor, and adds
words to his signature indicating that he signs for or on behalf of a principal, or in
a representative character, he is not personally liable thereon; but the mere addition
to his signature of words describing him as an agent, or as filling a representative
character, does not exempt him from personal liability.
(2) In determining whether a signature on a bill is that of the principal, or
that of the agent by whose hand it is written, the construction most favourable to
the validity of the instrument shall be adopted.

The Consideration for a Bill

27 Value and holder for value

(1) Valuable consideration for a bill may be constituted by –
(a) Any consideration sufficient to support a simple contract;
(b) An antecedent debt or liability. Such a debt or liability is deemed
valuable consideration whether the bill is payable on demand or at
a future time.
(2) Where value has at any time been given for a bill, the holder is deemed
to be a holder for value as regards the acceptor and all parties to the bill who
became parties prior to that time.
(3) Where the holder of a bill has a lien on it, arising either from contract or
by implication of law, he is deemed to be a holder for value to the amount of the
sum for which he has a lien.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

175

28 Accommodation party

(1) An accommodation party to a bill is a person who has signed a bill as
drawer, acceptor, or indorser without receiving value for it, and for the purpose
of lending his name to some other person.
(2) An accommodation party is liable on the bill to a holder for value; and
it is immaterial whether, when such holder took the bill, he knew such party to be
an accommodation party or not.

29 Holder in due course

(1) A holder in due course is a holder who has taken a bill, complete and
regular on the face of it, under the following conditions, namely:
(a) That he became the holder of it before it was overdue, and without
notice that it had been previously dishonoured, if such was the fact;
(b) That he took the bill in good faith and for value, and that at the
time the bill was negotiated to him he had no notice of any defect
in the title of the person who negotiated it.
(2) In particular, the title of a person who negotiates a bill is defective within
the meaning of this Act when he obtained the bill, or the acceptance thereof, by
fraud, duress, or force and fear, or other unlawful means, or for an illegal
consideration, or when he negotiates it in breach of faith, or under such
circumstances as amount to a fraud.
(3) A holder (whether for value or not) who derives his title to a bill through
a holder in due course, and who is not himself a party to any fraud or illegality
affecting it, has all the rights of that holder in due course as regards the acceptor
and all parties to the bill prior to that holder.

30 Presumption of value and good faith

(1) Every party whose signature appears on a bill is prima facie deemed to
have become a party thereto for value.
(2) Every holder of a bill is prima facie deemed to be a holder in due course;
but if in an action on a bill it is admitted or proved that the acceptance, issue, or
subsequent negotiation of the bill is affected with fraud, duress, or force and fear,
or illegality, the burden of proof is shifted, unless and until the holder proves that,
subsequent to the alleged fraud or illegality, value has in good faith been given
for the bill.

31 Negotiation of bill

Negotiation of Bills

(1) A bill is negotiated when it is transferred from one person to another in such a manner as to constitute the transferee the holder of the bill.
(2) A bill payable to bearer is negotiated by delivery.
(3) A bill payable to order is negotiated by the indorsement of the holder
completed by delivery.
(4) Where the holder of a bill payable to his order transfers it for value
without indorsing it, the transfer gives the transferee such title as the transferor
had in the bill, and the transferee in addition acquires the right to have the
indorsement of the transferor.
(5) Where any person is under obligation to indorse a bill in a representative
capacity, he may indorse the bill in such terms as to negative personal liability.
176 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

32 Requisition of a valid indorsement

An indorsement in order to operate as a negotiation must comply with the
following conditions –
(a) It must be written on the bill itself and be signed by the indorser;
the simple signature of the indorser on the bill, without additional
words, is sufficient:
Provided that an indorsement written on an allonge, or on a “copy”
of a bill issued or negotiated in a country where “copies” are
recognised, shall be deemed to be written on the bill itself;
(b) It must be an indorsement of the entire bill. A partial indorsement –
that is to say, an indorsement that purports to transfer to the indorsee
a part only of the amount payable, or to transfer the bill to 2 or
more indorsees severally – does not operate as a negotiation of the
bill;
(c) Where a bill is payable to the order of 2 or more payees or indorsees
who are not partners, all must indorse, unless the one indorsing
has authority to indorse for the others;
(d) Where in a bill payable to order the payee or indorsee is wrongly
designated, or his name is misspelt, he may indorse the bill as therein
described, adding, if he thinks fit, his proper signature;
(e) Where there are 2 or more indorsements on a bill, each indorsement
is deemed to have been made in the order in which it appears on
the bill, until the contrary is proved;
(f) An indorsement may be either special or in blank; it may also contain
terms making it restrictive.

33 Conditional indorsement

Where a bill purports to be indorsed conditionally, the condition may be
disregarded by the payer, and payment to the indorsee is valid whether the
conditions has been fulfilled or not.

34 Indorsement in blank, and special indorsement

(1) An indorsement in blank specifies no indorsee, and a bill so indorsed
becomes payable to bearer.
(2) A special indorsement specifies the person to whom, or to whose order,
the bill is to be payable.
(3) The provisions of this Act relating to a payee apply, with the necessary
modifications, to an indorsee under a special indorsement.
(4) Where a bill has been indorsed in blank, any holder may convert the
blank indorsement into a special indorsement by writing above the indorser ’s
signature a direction to pay the bill or to the order of himself or some other person.

35 Restrictive indorsement

(1) An indorsement is restrictive which prohibits the further negotiation
of the bill, or which expresses that is a mere authority to deal with the bill as
thereby directed and not a transfer of the ownership thereof – as, for example, if a
bill is indorsed “Pay D. only”, or “Pay D. for the account of X.”, or “Pay D. or
order for collection”.
(2) A restrictive indorsement gives the indorsee the right to receive payment
of the bill, and to sue any party thereto that his indorser could have sued, but
gives him no power to transfer his rights as indorsee unless it expressly authorises
him to do so.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

177
(3) Where a restrictive indorsement authorises further transfer, all subsequent indorsees take the bill with the same rights and subject to the same liabilities as the first indorsee under the restrictive indorsement.

36 Negotiation of overdue or dishonoured bill

(1) Where a bill is negotiable in its origin, it continues to be negotiable
until it has been either restrictively indorsed, or discharged by payment or
otherwise.
(2) Where an overdue bill is negotiated, it can be negotiated only subject
to any defect of title affecting it at its maturity, and thenceforward no person who
takes it can acquire or give a better title than that which the person from whom he
took it had.
(3) A bill payable on demand is deemed to be overdue within the meaning
and for the purposes of this section when it appears on the face of it to have been
in circulation for an unreasonable length of time. What is an unreasonable length
of time for this purpose is a question of fact.
(4) Except where an indorsement bears date after the maturity of the bill,
every negotiation is prima facie deemed to have been effected before the bill became
overdue.
(5) Where a bill that is not overdue has been dishonoured, any person who
takes it with notice of the dishonour takes it subject to any defect of title attaching
thereto at the time of dishonour: but nothing in this subsection shall affect the
rights of a holder in due course.

37 Negotiation of bill to party already liable thereon

Where a bill is negotiated back to the drawer, or to a prior indorser, or to
the acceptor, such party may, subject to this Act, reissue and further negotiate the
bill; but he is not entitled to enforce payment of the bill against any intervening
party to whom he was previously liable.

38 Rights of the holder

The rights and powers of the holder of a bill are as follows –
(a) He may sue on the bill in his own name;
(b) Where he is a holder in due course, he holds the bill free from any
defect of title of prior parties, as well as from mere personal defences
available to prior parties among themselves, and may enforce
payment against all parties liable on the bill;
(c) Where his title is defective –
(i) if he negotiates the bill to a holder in due course, that holder
obtains a good and complete title to the bill; and
(ii) if he obtains payment of the bill, the person who pays him in
due course gets a valid discharge for the bill.

General Duties of the Holder

39 When presentment for acceptance is necessary

(1) Where a bill is payable after sight, presentment for acceptance is
necessary in order to fix the maturity of the instrument.
(2) Where a bill expressly stipulates that it shall be presented for acceptance,
or where a bill is drawn payable elsewhere than at the residence or place of business
of the drawee, it must be presented for acceptance before it can be presented for
payment.
178 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) In no other case is presentment for acceptance necessary in order to render liable any party to the bill.
(4) Where the holder of a bill drawn payable elsewhere than at the place of business or residence of the drawee has not time, with the exercise of reasonable diligence, to present the bill for acceptance before presenting it for payment on the day that it falls due, the delay caused by presenting the bill for acceptance before presenting it for payment is excused, and does not discharge the drawer and indorsers.

40 Time for presenting bill payable after sight

(1) Subject to this Act, where a bill payable after sight is negotiated, the
holder must either present it for acceptance or negotiate it within a reasonable
time.
(2) If he does not do so, the drawer and all indorsers prior to that holder are discharged.
(3) In determining what is a reasonable time within the meaning of this section, regard shall be had to the nature of the bill, the usage of trade with respect to similar bills, and the facts of the particular case.

41 Rules as to presentment for acceptance and excuses for non-presentment

(1) A bill is duly presented for acceptance if it is presented under the
following rules –
(a) The presentment must be made by or on behalf of the holder to the
drawee, or to some person authorised to accept or to refuse
acceptance on his behalf, at a reasonable hour on a business day
and before the bill is overdue;
(b) Where a bill is addressed to 2 or more drawees, who are not partners,
presentment must be made to them all, unless one has authority to
accept for all, in which case presentment may be made to him only;
(c) Where the drawee is dead, presentment may be made to his executor
or administrator;
(d) Where the drawee is bankrupt, presentment may be made to him
or to his assignee;
(e) Where authorised by agreement or usage, a presentment through
the post office is sufficient.
(2) Presentment in accordance with these rules is excused, and a bill may
be treated as dishonoured by non-acceptance –
(f) Where the drawee is dead or bankrupt, or is a fictitious person, or
a person not having capacity to contract by bill;
(g) Where, after the exercise of reasonable diligence, such presentment
cannot be effected;
(h) Where, although the presentment has been irregular, acceptance
has been refused on some other ground.
(3) The fact that the holder has reason to believe that the bill, on
presentment, will be dishonoured does not excuse presentment.

42 Non-acceptance

Where a bill is duly presented for acceptance and is not accepted within
the customary time, the person presenting it must treat it as dishonoured by non­
acceptance. If he does not, the holder shall lose his right of recourse against the
drawer and indorsers.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

179

43 Dishonour by non-acceptance and its consequences

(1) A bill is dishonoured by non-acceptance –
(a) Where it is duly presented for acceptance, and such an acceptance
as is prescribed by this Act is refused, or cannot be obtained; or
(b) Where presentment for acceptance is excused and the bill is not
accepted.
(2) Subject to this Act, when a bill is dishonoured by non-acceptance an
immediate right of recourse against the drawer and indorsers accrues to the holder,
and no presentment for payment is necessary.

44 Qualified acceptance

(1) The holder of a bill may refuse to take a qualified acceptance, and if he
does not obtain a general acceptance may treat the bill as dishonoured by non­
acceptance.
(2) Where a qualified acceptance is taken, and the drawer or an indorser
has not expressly or impliedly authorised the holder to take a qualified acceptance,
or does not subsequently assent thereto, such drawer or indorser is discharged
from his liability on the bill. The provisions of this subsection do not apply to a
partial acceptance whereof due notice has been given. Where a foreign bill has
been accepted as to part, it must be protested as to the balance.
(3) Where the drawer or indorser of a bill receives notice of a qualified
acceptance, and does not within a reasonable time express his dissent to the holder,
he shall be deemed to have assented to it.

45 Rules as to presentment for payment

(1) Subject to this Act, a bill must be duly presented for payment. If it is
not so presented, the drawer and indorsers shall be discharged.
(2) A bill is duly presented for payment if it is presented in accordance
with the following rules –
(a) Where the bill is not payable on demand, presentment must be made
on the day it falls due;
(b) (i) Where the bill is payable on demand, then, subject to this Act,
presentment must be made within a reasonable time after its
issue in order to render the drawer liable, and within a
reasonable time after its indorsement in order to render the
indorser liable;
(ii) In determining what is a reasonable time regard shall be had to
the nature of the bill, the usage of trade with regard to similar
bills, and the facts of the particular case;
(c) Presentment must be made by the holder, or by some person
authorised to receive payment on his behalf, at a reasonable hour
on a business day, at the proper place as hereinafter defined, either
to the person designated by the bill as payer, or to some person
authorised to pay or refuse payment on his behalf, if by the exercise
of reasonable diligence such person can there be found;
(d) A bill is presented at the proper place –
(i) where a place of payment is specified in the bill, and the bill is
there presented;
(ii) where no place of payment is specified, but the address of the
drawee or acceptor is given in the bill, and the bill is there
presented;
180 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(iii) where no place of payment is specified and no address given, and the bill is presented at the drawee’s or acceptor ’s place of business, if known, and if not, at his ordinary residence, if known;
(iv) in any other case, if presented to the drawee or acceptor at his last known place of business or residence, or wherever he can be found.
(e) Where a bill is presented at the proper place, and after the exercise of reasonable diligence no person authorised to pay or refuse payment can be found there, no further presentment to the drawee or acceptor is required;
(f) Where a bill is drawn upon or accepted by two or more persons
who are not partners, and no place of payment is specified,
presentment must be made to them all;
(g) Where the drawee or acceptor of the bill is dead, and no place of
payment is specified, presentment must be made to the executor or
administrator of the deceased, if any, and if by the exercise of
reasonable diligence he can be found;
(h) Where authorised by agreement or usage, presentment through the
post office is sufficient.

46 Excuses for delay or non-presentment for payment

(1) (a) Delay in making presentment for payment is excused when the
delay is caused by circumstances beyond the control of the holder,
and not imputable to his default, misconduct, or negligence.
(b) When the cause of delay ceases to operate, presentment must be
made with reasonable diligence.
(2) Presentment for payment is dispensed with –
(a) Where, after the exercise of reasonable diligence, presentment as
required by this Act cannot be effected: The fact that the holder has
reason to believe that the bill will, on presentment, be dishonoured,
does not dispense with the necessity for presentment;
(b) Where the drawee is a fictitious person;
(c) As regards the drawer, where the drawee or acceptor is not bound,
as between himself and the drawer, to accept or pay the bill, and
the drawer has no reason to believe that the bill would be paid if
presented;
(d) As regards an indorser, where the bill was accepted or made for the
accommodation of that indorser, and he has no reason to believe
that the bill would be paid if presented;
(e) By waiver of presentment, express or implied.

47 Dishonour by non-payment

(1) A bill is dishonoured by non-payment –
(a) Where it is duly presented for payment and payment is refused, or
cannot be obtained; or
(b) Where presentment is excused and the bill is overdue and unpaid.
(2) Subject to this Act, where a bill is dishonoured by non-payment an
immediate right of recourse against the drawers or indorsers accrues to the holder.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

181

48 Notice of dishonour

(1) Subject to this Act, where a bill has been dishonoured by non-acceptance
or by non-payment, notice of dishonour must be given to the drawer and each
indorser, and any drawer or indorser to whom such notice is not given is
discharged;
(2) (a) Where a bill is dishonoured by non-acceptance, and notice of
dishonour is not given, the rights of a holder in due course
subsequent to the omission shall not be prejudiced by the omission.
(b) Where a bill is dishonoured by non-acceptance, and due notice of
dishonour is given, it shall not be necessary to give notice of a
subsequent dishonour by non-payment unless the bill has in the
meantime been accepted.

49 Rules as to notice of dishonour

Notice of dishonour in order to be valid and effectual must be given in
accordance with the following rules –
(a) The notice must be given by or on behalf of the holder, or by or on
behalf of an indorser who, at the time of giving it, is himself liable
on the bill;
(b) Notice of dishonour may be given by an agent either in his own
name or in the name of any party entitled to give notice, whether
that party is his principal or not;
(c) Where the notice is given by or on behalf of the holder, it enures for
the benefit of all subsequent holders and all prior indorsers having
a right of recourse against the party to whom it is given;
(d) Where notice is given by or on behalf of an indorser entitled to give
notice as hereinbefore provided, it enures for the benefit of the
holder and all indorsers subsequent to the party to whom notice is
given;
(e) The notice may be given either in writing by personal
communication, and may be given in any terms sufficient to identify
the bill, and intimating that the bill has been dishonoured by non­
acceptance or non-payment;
(f) The return of a dishonoured bill to the drawer or an indorser is in
point of form deemed a sufficient notice of dishonour;
(g) A written notice need not be signed, and an insufficient written
notice may be supplemented and made valid by verbal
communication;
(h) A misdescription of the bill shall not vitiate the notice unless the
party to whom the notice is given is in fact misled by it;
(i) Where notice of dishonour is required to be given to any person, it
may be given either to the party himself or to his agent in that behalf;
(j) Where the drawer or indorser is dead, and the party giving notice
is aware of the fact, the notice must be given to an executor or
administrator of the deceased, if any, and if by the exercise of
reasonable diligence he can be found;
(k) Where the drawer or indorser is bankrupt, notice may be given
either to the party himself or to his assignee;
(l) Where there are more than 2 drawers or indorsers, who are not
partners, notice must be given to each of them, unless one of them
has authority to receive such notice on behalf of the others;
182

50

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

(m) The notice may be given as soon as the bill is dishonoured, and must be given within a reasonable time thereafter;
(n) In the absence of special circumstances, notice is not deemed to have been given within a reasonable time unless –
(i) Where the person giving and the person to receive notice reside in the same place, the notice is given or sent off in time to reach the latter on the day after the dishonour of the bill;
(ii) Where the person giving and the person to receive notice reside in different places, the notice is sent off on the day after the dishonour of the bill, if there is a post at a convenient hour on that day, and, if there is no such post on that day, then by the next post thereafter;
(o) Where a bill when dishonoured is in the hands of an agent, he may either himself give notice to the parties liable on the bill, or he may give notice to his principal. If he gives notice of his principal, he must do so within the same time as if he were the holder; and the principal, upon receipt of such notice, has himself the same time for giving notice as if the agent had been an independent holder;
(p) Where a party to a bill receives due notice of dishonour, he has after the receipt of such notice the same period of time for giving notice to antecedent parties that the holder has after the dishonour;
(q) Where a notice of dishonour is duly addressed and posted, the sender is deemed to have given due notice of dishonour notwithstanding any miscarriage by the post office.

Excuses for want of notice and delay

(1) (a) Delay in giving notice of dishonour is excused where the delay is
caused by circumstances beyond the control of the party giving
notice, and not imputable to his default, misconduct, or negligence;
(b) When the cause of delay ceases to operate the notice must be given
with reasonable diligence.
(2) Notice of dishonour is dispensed with –
(a) When, after the exercise of reasonable diligence, notice as required
by this Act cannot be given to or does not reach the drawer or
indorser sought to be charged;
(b) By waiver, express or implied, either before the time of giving notice
of dishonour has arrived, or after the omission to give due notice;
(c) As regards the drawer, in the following cases, namely –
(i) where the drawer and drawee are the same person;
(ii) where the drawee is a fictitious person, or a person not having
capacity to contract;
(iii) where the drawer is the person to whom the bill is presented
for payment;
(iv) where the drawee or acceptor is as between himself and the
drawer under no obligation to accept or pay the bill;
(v) where the drawer has countermanded payment.
(d) As regards the indorser, in the following cases, namely –
(i) where the drawee is a fictitious person, or a person not having
capacity to contract, and the indorser was aware of the fact at
the time he indorsed the bill;
(ii) where the indorser is the person to whom the bill is presented
for payment;
(iii) where the bill was accepted and made for his accommodation.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

183

51 Noting or protest of bill

(1) Where an inland bill has been dishonoured it may be noted for non­
acceptance or non-payment, as the case may be; but it shall not be necessary to note or protest any such bill in order to preserve the recourse against the drawer or indorser.
(2) Where a foreign bill, appearing on the fact of it to be such, has been
dishonoured by non-acceptance it must be duly protested for non-acceptance,
and where such a bill, not having been previously dishonoured by non-acceptance,
is dishonoured by non-payment it must be duly protested for non-payment,
otherwise the drawer and indorsers are discharged.
(3) Where a bill does not appear on the face of it to be a foreign bill, protest
of it as in case of dishonour is unnecessary.
(4) A bill that has been protested for non-acceptance may be subsequently
protested for non-payment.
(5) Subject to this Act, where a bill is noted or protested it must be noted
on the day of dishonour.
(6) Where a bill has been duly noted, the protest may be subsequently
extended so as to take effect from the date of the noting.
(7) Where the acceptor of a bill becomes bankrupt or insolvent or suspends
payment before it matures, the holder may cause the bill to be protested for better
security against the drawer and indorsers.
(8) (a) A bill must be protested at the place where it is dishonoured.
(b) Where a bill is presented through the post office, and returned by
post dishonoured, it may be protested at the place to which it is
returned and on the day of its return if received during business
hours, and if not received during business hours, then not later
than the next business day.
(c) When a bill drawn payable at the place of business or residence of
some person other than the drawee has been dishonoured by non­
acceptance, it must be protested for non-payment at the place where
it is expressed to be payable, and no further presentment for
payment to or demand on the drawee is necessary.
(9) A protest must contain a copy of the bill, and must be signed by the
notary making it, and must specify –
(a) The person at whose request the bill is protested;
(b) The place and date of protest, the cause or reason for protesting the
bill, the demand made, and the answer given, if any, or the fact that
the drawee or acceptor could not be found.
(10) Where a bill is lost or destroyed, or is wrongly detained from the person
entitled to hold it, protest may be made on a copy or on written particulars of it.
(11) Protest is dispensed with by any circumstance that would dispense
with notice of dishonour.
(12) Delay in noting or protesting is excused when the delay is caused by
circumstances beyond the control of the holder, and not imputable to his default,
misconduct, or negligence. When the cause of delay ceases to operate the bill must
be noted or protested with reasonable diligence.
184 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

52 Duties of holder as regards drawee or acceptor

(1) When a bill is accepted generally, presentment for payment is not
necessary in order to render the acceptor liable.
(2) When by the terms of a qualified acceptance presentment for payment
is required, the acceptor, in the absence of an express stipulation to that effect, is
not discharged by the omission to present the bill for payment on the day that it
matures.
(3) In order to render the acceptor of a bill liable is not necessary to protest
it, or that notice of dishonour should be given to him.
(4) When the holder of a bill presents it for payment, he shall exhibit the
bill to the person from whom he demands payment, and when a bill is paid the
holder shall forthwith deliver it up to the party paying it.

Liabilities of Parties

53 Funds in hands of drawee

A bill of itself does not operate as an assignment of funds in the hands of
the drawee available for the payment of it, and the drawee of a bill who does not
accept as required by this Act is not liable on the instrument.

54 Liability of acceptor

The acceptor of a bill, by accepting it –
(a) Engages that he will pay it under the tenor of his acceptance;
(b) Is precluded from denying to a holder in due course –
(i) the existence of the drawer, the genuineness of his signature,
and his capacity and authority to draw the bill;
(ii) in the case of a bill payable to drawer ’s order, the then capacity
of the drawer to indorse, but not the genuineness or validity of
his indorsement;
(iii) in the case of a bill payable to the order of a third person, the
existence of the payee and his then capacity to indorse, but not
the genuineness or validity of his indorsement.

55 Liability of drawer or indorser

(1) The drawer of a bill, by drawing it –
(a) Engages that on due presentation it shall be accepted and paid under
its tenor, and that if it is dishonoured he will compensate the holder
or any indorser who is compelled to pay it, provided that the
requisite proceedings on dishonour are duly taken;
(b) Is precluded from denying to a holder in due course the existence
of the payee and his then capacity to indorse.
(2) The indorser of a bill, by indorsing it –
(a) Engages that on due presentment it shall be accepted and paid
according to its tenor, and that if it is dishonoured he will
compensate the holder or a subsequent indorser who is compelled
to pay it, provided that the requisite proceedings on dishonour are
duly taken;
(b) Is precluded from denying to a holder in due course the genuineness
and regularity in all respects of the drawer ’s signature and all
previous indorsements;
(c) Is precluded from denying to his immediate or a subsequent
indorsee that he bill was at the time of his indorsement a valid and
subsisting bill, and that he had then a good title to it.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

185

56 Stranger signing bill liable as indorser

Where a person signs a bill otherwise than as drawer or acceptor, he thereby
incurs the liabilities of an indorser to a holder in due course.

57 Measure of damages against parties to dishonoured bill

Where a bill is dishonoured, the measure of damages, which shall be deemed
to be liquidated damages, shall be as follows –
(a) The holder may recover from any party liable on the bill, and the
drawer who has been compelled to pay the bill may recover from
the acceptor, and an indorser who has been compelled to pay the
bill may recover from the acceptor or from the drawer, or from a
prior indorser –
(i) the amount of the bill;
(ii) interest thereon from the time of presentment for payment if
the bill is payable on demand, and from the maturity of the bill
in any other case;
(iii) the expenses of noting, or, when protest is necessary and the
protest has been extended, the expenses of protest;
(b) In the case of a bill that has been dishonoured abroad, in lieu of the
above damages the holder may recover from the drawer or an
indorser, and the drawer or an indorser who has been compelled to
pay the bill may recover from any party liable to him, the amount
of the re-exchange, with interest thereon until the time of payment;
(c) Where by this Act interest may be recovered as damages, such
interest may, if justice requires it, be withheld wholly or in part,
and, where a bill is expressed to be payable with interest at a given
rate, interest as damages may or may not be given at the same rate
as interest proper.

58 Transferor and transferee by delivery

(1) Where the holder of a bill payable to bearer negotiates it by delivery
without indorsing it, he is called a “transferor by delivery”.
(2) A transferor by delivery is not liable on the instrument.
(3) A transferor by delivery who negotiates a bill thereby warrants to his
immediate transferee being a holder for value that the bill is what it purports to
be, that he has a right to transfer it, and that at the time of transfer he is not award
of any fact which renders it valueless.

59 Payment in due course

Discharge of Bill

(1) A bill is discharged by payment in due course by or on behalf of the drawee or acceptor.
(2) “Payment in due course” means payment to the holder of the bill made at or after its maturity in good faith and without notice that the holder ’s title is defective.
(3) When a bill is paid by the drawer or an indorser it is not discharged,
but –
(a) Where a bill payable to or to the order of a third party is paid by the drawer, the drawer my enforce payment of it against the acceptor, but may not reissue the bill;
(b) Where a bill is paid by an indorser, or where a bill payable to drawer ’s order is paid by the drawer, the party paying it is remitted
186 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
to his former rights as regards the acceptor or antecedent parties, and may, strike out his own and subsequent indorsements, and again negotiate the bill.
(4) Where an accommodation bill is paid in due course by the party accommodated the bill is discharged.

60 Banker paying on demand draft bearing forged indorsement

(1) Where a bill payable to order on demand is drawn on a banker, and the
banker on whom it is drawn pays the bill in good faith and in the ordinary course
of business, it is not incumbent on the banker to show that the indorsement of the
payee or any subsequent indorsement was made by or under the authority of the
person whose indorsement it purports to be, and the banker is deemed to have
paid the bill in due course, although such indorsement has been forged or made
without authority.
(2) Where a banker carries on the business of banking at more branches
than one he shall for the purposes of this section, be deemed to be an independent
banker in respect of each of such branches, and a draft issued by one of such
branches and payable at another shall be deemed to be a bill.

61 Where acceptor the holder at maturity

Where the acceptor of a bill is or becomes the holder of it in his own right,
oat or after its maturity, the bill is discharged.

62 Holder may waive his rights

(1) (a) Where the holder of a bill at or after its maturity absolutely and
unconditionally renounces his rights against the acceptor the bill is
discharged.
(b) The renunciation must be in writing, unless the bill is delivered up
to the acceptor.
(2) The liabilities of any party to a bill may in like manner be renounced by
the holder before, at, or after its maturity.
(3) Nothing in this section shall affect the rights of a holder in due course
without notice of any such renunciation.

63 Cancellation

(1) Where a bill is intentionally cancelled by the holder or his agent, and
the cancellation is apparent on it, the bill is discharged.
(2) (a) Any party liable on a bill may in like manner be discharged by the
intentional cancellation of his signature by the holder or his agent.
(b) In such case an indorser who would have had a right of recourse
against the party whose signature has been cancelled is also
discharged.
(3) A cancellation made unintentionally, or under a mistake, or without
the authority of the holder, is inoperative; but where a bill or any signature thereon
appears to have been cancelled the burden of proof lies on the party who alleges
that the cancellation was made unintentionally, or under a mistake or without
authority.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

187

64 Alteration of bill

(1) (a) Where a bill or acceptance is materially altered without the assent
of all parties liable on the bill, the bill is avoided except as against a
party who has himself made, authorised, or assented to the
alteration, and subsequent indorsers.
(b) Where a bill has been materially altered, but the alteration is not
apparent, and the bill is in the hands of a holder in due course,
such holder may avail himself of the bill as if it had not been altered,
and may enforce payment of it under its original tenor.
(2) In particular, the following alterations are material, namely, any
alteration of the date, the sum payable, the time of payment, the place of payment, and, where a bill has been accepted generally, the addition of a place of payment without the acceptor ’s assent.

Acceptance and Payment for Honour

65 Acceptance for honour supra protest

(1) Where a bill of exchange has been protested for dishonour by non­
acceptance, or protested for better security, and is not overdue, any person, not
being a party already liable on it, may, with the consent of the holder, intervene
and accept the bill supra protest, for the honour of any party liable on it, or for the
honour of a person on whose account the bill is drawn.
(2) A bill may be accepted for honour for part only of the sum for which it
is drawn.
(3) An acceptance for honour supra protest in order to be valid must –
(a) Be written on the bill, and indicate that it is an acceptance for honour;
and
(b) Be signed by the acceptor for honour.
(4) Where an acceptance for honour does not expressly state for whose
honour it is made, it is deemed to be an acceptance for the honour of the drawer.
(5) Where a bill payable after sight is accepted for honour, its maturity is
calculated from the date of the noting for non-acceptance, and not from the date
of the acceptance for honour.

66 Liability of acceptor for honour

(1) The acceptor for honour of a bill by accepting it engages that he will,
on due presentment, pay the bill according to the tenor of his acceptance, if it is
not paid by the drawee, provided that it has been duly presented for payment
and protested for non-payment, and that he receives notice of these facts.
(2) The acceptor for honour is liable to the holder and to all parties to the
bill subsequent to the party for whose honour he has accepted.

67 Presentation to acceptor for honour

(1) Where a dishonoured bill has been accepted for honour supra protest,
or contains a reference in case of need, it must be protested for non-payment before
it is presented for payment to the acceptor for honour or referee in case of need.
(2) Where the address of the acceptor for honour is in the same place where
the bill is protested for non-payment, the bill must be presented to him not later
than the day following its maturity; and where the address of the acceptor for
honour is in some place other than the place where it was protested for non­
payment, the bill must be forwarded for presentment to him not later than the
day following its maturity.
188 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) Delay in presentment, or non-presentment is excused by any circumstance that would excuse delay in presentment for payment, or non- presentment for payment.
(4) Where a bill is dishonoured by the acceptor for honour it must be protested for non-payment by him.

68 Payment for honour supra protest

(1) Where a bill has been protested for non-payment, any person may
intervene and pay it supra protest for the honour of any party liable on it, or for
the honour of the person on whose account the bill is drawn.
(2) Where 2 or more persons offer to pay a bill for the honour of different
parties, the person whose payment will discharge most parties to the bill shall
have the preference.
(3) Payment for honour supra protest, in order to operate as such and not
as a mere voluntary payment, must be attested by a notarial act of honour, which
may be appended to the protest or may form an extension of it.
(4) The notarial act of honour must be founded on a declaration made by
the payer for honour, or his agent in that behalf, declaring his intention to pay the
bill for honour, and for whose honour he pays.
(5) Where a bill has been paid for honour, all parties subsequent to the
party for whose honour it is paid are discharged, but the payer for honour is
subrogated for and succeeds to both the rights and duties of the holder, as regards
the party for whose honour he pays and all parties liable to that party.
(6) The payer for honour, on paying to the holder the amount of the bill
and the notarial expenses incidental to its dishonour, is entitled to receive both
the bill itself and the protest, and if the holder does not deliver them up on demand
he shall be liable to the payer for honour in damages.
(7) Where the holder of a bill refuses to receive payment supra protest, he
shall lose his right of recourse against any party who would have been discharged
by such payment.

Lost Bills

69 Holder’s right to duplicate of lost bill

(1) Where a bill has been lost before it is overdue, the person who was the
holder of it may apply to the drawer to give him another bill of the same tenor,
giving security to the drawer if required to indemnify him against all persons
whatever in case the bill alleged to have been lost is found again.
(2) If the drawer, on request as aforesaid, refuses to give such duplicate
bill, he may be compelled to do so.

70 Action on lost bill

In any action or proceeding upon a bill, the Court or a Judge may order
that the loss of the instrument shall not be set up, provided an indemnity is given
to the satisfaction of the Court or Judge against the claims of any other person
upon the instrument in question.

71 Rules as to sets

Bill in a Set

(1) Where a bill is drawn in a set, each part of the set being numbered, and containing a reference to the other parts, the whole of the parts constitute one bill. (2) Where the holder of a set indorses 2 or more parts to different persons,
he is liable on every such part, and every indorser subsequent to him is liable on the part he has himself indorsed as if the said parts were separate bills.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

189
(3) Where 2 or more parts of a set are negotiated to different holders in due course, the holder whose title first accrues it, as between such holders deemed the true owner of the bill; but nothing in this subsection shall affect the rights of a person who in due course accepts or pays the part first presented to him.
(4) The acceptance may be written on any part, and it must be written on one part only.
(5) If the drawee accepts more than one part, and such accepted parts get into the hands of different holders in due course, he is liable on every part as if it were a separate bill.
(6) Where the acceptor of a bill dawn in a set pays it without requiring the part bearing his acceptance to be delivered up to him and that part at maturity is outstanding in the hands of a holder in due course, he is liable to the holder thereof. (7) Subject to the preceding rules where any one part of a bill drawn in a
set is discharged by payment or otherwise, the whole bill is discharged.

Conflict of Laws

72 Law governing contracts contained in a bill

Where a bill drawn in one country is negotiated, accepted, or payable in
another, the rights, duties, and liabilities of the parties thereto are determined as follows –
(a) The validity of a bill as regards requisites in form is determined by
the law of the place of issue, and the validity as regards requisites
in form of the supervening contracts, such as acceptance, or
indorsement, or acceptance supra protest, is in each case determined
by the law of the place where the contract was made:
Provided that –
(i) Where a bill is issued out of Niue it is not invalid by reason
only that it is not stamped in accordance with the law of the
place of issue;
(ii) Where a bill issued out of Niue conforms, as regards requisites
in form, to the law of Niue it may, for the purpose of enforcing
payment thereof, be treated as valid as between all persons
who negotiate, hold, or become parties to it in Niue;
(b) Subject to this Act, the interpretation of the drawing, indorsement,
acceptance, or acceptance supra protest of a bill is determined by
the law of the place where such contract was made:
Provided that where an inland bill is indorsed in a foreign country the
indorsement shall, as regards the payer, be interpreted under the law of Niue;
(c) The duties of the holder with respect to presentment for acceptance
or payment and the necessity for or sufficiency of a protest or notice
of dishonour, or otherwise, are determined by the law of the place
where the act is done or the bill is dishonoured;
(d) Where a bill is drawn out of but is payable in Niue and the sum
payable is not expressed in the currency of Niue, the amount shall,
in the absence of some express stipulation, be calculated under the
rate of exchange for sight drafts at the place of payment on the day
the bill is payable;
(e) Where a bill is drawn in one country and is payable in another, the
due date thereof is determined under the law of the place where it
is payable.
190 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

73 “Cheque” defined

PART 2
CHEQUES ON A BANK
(1) A cheque is a bill of exchange drawn on a banker payable on demand. (2) Except as otherwise provided in this Part, the provisions applicable to
a bill of exchange payable on demand apply to a cheque.

74 Presentment of cheques for payment

Subject to this Act, –
(a) Where a cheque is not presented for payment within a reasonable
time after its issue, and the drawer or the person on whose account
it is drawn had the right at the time of such presentment as between
himself and the banker to have the cheque paid, and suffers actual
damage through the delay, he is discharged to the extent of such
damage – that is to say, to the extent to which such drawer or person
is a creditor of such banker to a larger amount than he would have
been had such cheque been paid;
(b) In determining what is a reasonable time regard shall be had to the
nature of the instrument, the usage of trade and of bankers, and the
facts of the particular case;
(c) The holder of such cheque as to which such drawer or person is
discharged shall be a creditor, in lieu of such drawer or person, of
such banker to the extent of such discharge, and shall be entitled to
recover the amount from him.

75 Revocation of banker’s authority

(1) The duty and authority of a banker to pay a cheque drawn on him by
his customer are determined by –
(a) Countermand of payment;
(b) Notice of the customer ’s death.
(2) Notwithstanding section 1(b) a banker may pay a cheque drawn on
him, notwithstanding that he has notice of the death of the customer who drew it,
if the cheque is presented not more than 10 days after the date of the customer ’s
death, unless –
(a) The cheque is dated after that date; or
(b) The banker receives a countermand of payment by a person who
claims to be entitled to a grant of administration in respect of or to
be a beneficiary of the customer ’s estate.

Crossed Cheques

76 General and special crossings defined

(1) Where a cheque bears across its face an addition of –
(a) The words “and company” or “bank” or any abbreviation between
2 parallel transverse lines, either with or without the words “not
negotiable“; or
(b) 2 parallel transverse lines simply, either with or without the words
“not negotiable” –
that addition constitutes a crossing, and the cheque is crossed generally.
(2) Where a cheque bears across its face an addition of the name of a banker,
either with or without the words “not negotiable”, that addition constitutes a
crossing, and the cheque is crossed specially, and to that banker.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

191

77 Crossing by drawer or after issue

(1) A cheque may be crossed generally or specially by the drawer.
(2) Where a cheque is uncrossed, the holder may cross it generally or
specially.
(3) Where a cheque is crossed generally, the holder may cross it specially.
(4) Where a cheque is crossed generally or specially, the holder may add
the words “Not negotiable”.
(5) Where a cheque is crossed specially, the banker to whom it is crossed
may again cross it specially to another banker for collection.
(6) Where an uncrossed cheque, or a cheque crossed generally, is sent to a
banker for collection, the banker may cross it specially to himself.

78 Crossing to be deemed a material part of cheque

A crossing authorised by this Act is a material part of the cheque, and no
person may obliterate or, except as authorised by this Act, add to or alter the
crossing.

79 Duties of banker as to crossed cheques

(1) Where a cheque is crossed specially to more than one banker, except
when crossed to an agent for collection being a banker, the banker on whom it is
drawn shall refuse payment thereof.
(2) Where the banker on whom a cheque so crossed is drawn nevertheless
pays the same, or pays a cheque crossed generally otherwise than to a banker, or
if crossed specially otherwise than to the banker to whom it is crossed, or his
agent for collection being a banker, he is liable to the true owner of the cheque for
any loss he may sustain owing to the cheque having been so paid.
(3) Where a cheque presented for payment does not at the time of
presentment appear to be crossed, or to have had a crossing which has been
obliterated, or to have been added to or altered otherwise than as authorised by
this Act, the banker paying the cheque in good faith and without negligence shall
not be responsible or incur any liability, nor shall the payment be questioned by
reason of the cheque having been crossed, or of the crossing having been obliterated
or having been added to or altered otherwise than as authorised by this Act, and
of payment having been made otherwise than to a banker, or to the banker to
whom the cheque is or was crossed, or to his agent for collection being a banker,
as the case may be.

80 Protection to banker and drawer where cheque is crossed

Where the banker on whom a crossed cheque is drawn pays it in good faith
and without negligence, if crossed generally, to a banker, and, if crossed specially,
to the banker to whom it is crossed, or to his agent for collection being a banker,
the banker paying the cheque, and, if the cheque has come into the hands of the
payee, the drawer, shall respectively be entitled to the same rights and be placed
in the same position as if payment of the cheque has been made to the true owner.

81 Effect of the words “Not negotiable”

Where a person takes a crossed cheque bearing on it the words “Not
negotiable”, he shall not have and shall not be capable of giving a better title to
the cheque than that which the person from whom he took it had.

82 [Repealed 1960/s8(1)]

192 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

83 Branch banks deemed independent banks for certain purposes

Where a banker carries on the business of banking at more branches than one
he shall, for the purposes of section 76 to 81 and for the purposes of the Cheques Act
1960, be deemed to be an independent banker in respect of each of such branches.
PART 3
PROMISSORY NOTES

84 “Promissory note” defined

(1) A promissory note is an unconditional promise in writing made by one
person to another, signed buy the maker, engaging to pay on demand, or at a
fixed or determinable future time, a sum certain in money to or to the order of a
specified person or to a bearer.
(2) An instrument in the form of a note payable to maker ’s order is not a
note within the meaning of this section unless and until it is indorsed by the maker.
(3) A note is not invalid by reason only that it contains also a pledge of
collateral security, with authority to sell or dispose thereof.
(4) A note that is, or on the face of it purports to be, both made and payable
in Niue is an inland note; any other note is a foreign note.

85 Delivery necessary

A promissory note is incomplete until delivery to the payee or bearer.

86 Joint and several notes

(1) A promissory note may be made by 2 or more makers, and they may be
liable thereon jointly, or jointly and severally, according to its tenor.
(2) Where a note runs “I promise to pay” and is signed by 2 or more persons,
it is deemed to be their joint and several note.

87 Note payable on demand

(1) (a) Where a note payable on demand is indorsed, it must be presented
for payment within a reasonable time of the indorsement.
(b) If it is not so presented, the indorser is discharged.
(2) In determining what is a reasonable time regard shall be had to the
nature of the instrument, the usage of trade, and the facts of the particular case.
(3) Where a note payable on demand is negotiated, it is not deemed to be
overdue, for the purposes of affecting the holder with defects of title of which he
had no notice, by reason that it appears that a reasonable time for presenting it for
payment has elapsed since its issue.

88 Presentment of note for payment

(1) Where a promissory note is in the body of it made payable at a particular
place, it must be presented for payment at that place in order to render the maker
liable; but in any other case presentment for payment is not necessary in order to
render the maker liable.
(2) Presentment for payment is necessary in order to render the indorser
of a note liable.
(3) Where a note is in the body of it made payable at a particular place,
presentment at that place is necessary in order to render an indorser liable; but
when a place of payment is indicated by way of memorandum only, presentment
at that place is sufficient to render the indorser liable, but a presentment to the
maker elsewhere, if sufficient in other respects, shall also suffice.

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

193

89 Liability of maker

The maker of a promissory note, by making it –
(a) Engages that he will pay it under is tenor;
(b) Is precluded from denying to a holder in due course the existence
of the payee and his then capacity to indorse.

90 Application of Part 1 to notes

(1) Subject to this Part the provisions of this Act relating to bills of exchange
apply, with the necessary modifications, to promissory notes.
(2) In applying those provisions the maker of a note shall be deemed to
correspond with the acceptor of a bill, and the first indorser of a note shall be
deemed to correspond with the drawer of an accepted bill payable to drawer ’s
order.
(3) The following provisions as to bills do not apply to notes – (a) Presentment for acceptance;
(b) Acceptance;
(c) Acceptance supra protest;
(d) Bills in a set.
(4) Where a foreign note is dishonoured, protest of it is unnecessary.

91 Good faith

PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS
A thing is deemed to be done in good faith within the meaning of this Act where it is in fact done honestly, whether it is done negligently or not.

92 Signature

(1) Where by this Act any instrument or writing is required to be signed
by any person, it is not necessary that he should sign it with his own hand, but it
is sufficient if his signature is written on it by some other person by or under his
authority.
(2) Where a corporation makes any instrument or writing required to be
signed, it is sufficient if the instrument or writing is sealed with the corporate seal.
(3) Nothing in this section shall be construed as requiring the bill or note
of a corporation to be under seal.

93 Computation of time

Where by this Act the time limited for doing any act or thing is less than 3
days, in reckoning time non-business days are excluded.

94 When noting equivalent to protest

For the purposes of this Act, where a bill or note is required to be protested
within a specified time or before some further proceeding is taken, it is sufficient
that the bill has been noted for protest before the expiration of the specified time
or the taking of the proceeding; and the formal protest may be extended at any
time thereafter to take effect from the date of the noting.
194 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

95 Protest when notary not accessible

(1) Where a dishonoured bill or note is authorised or required to be
protested, and the services of a notary cannot be obtained at the place where the
bill is dishonoured, any householder or substantial resident of the place may, in
the presence of 2 witnesses, give a certificate, signed by them, attesting the
dishonour of the bill, and the certificate shall in all respects operate as if it were a
formal protest of the bill.
(2) The form given in Schedule 2 may be used with necessary
modifications, and if used shall be sufficient.

96 Bill drawn at sight to be deemed a bill payable on demand

Every bill of exchange or promissory note drawn and purporting to be
payable at the sight or on presentation shall be stamped as and shall for all purposes
be deemed to be a bill of exchange or promissory note payable on demand without
any days of grace, any law or custom or to the contrary notwithstanding.
they are inconsistent with the express provisions of this Act, shall continue to apply to bills of exchange, promissory note, and cheques.

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Section 1 (2)

[Spent]

SCHEDULE 2

Section 95 (2)

PROTEST WHERE THE SERVICES OF A NOTARY CANNOT BE OBTAINED

Know all men that I, A.B. [householder] of , in Niue at

the request of C.D., there being no notary public available did on the day of 20

, at , demand payment [or acceptance] of the bill of exchange hereunder written,

from E.F., to which demand he made answer [State answer, if any]: Wherefore I now, in

the presence of G.H. and J.K., do protest the said bill of exchange.

G.H.) Witnesses

J.K. )

(Signed) A.B.

[NB. The bill itself should be annexed, or a copy of the bill and all that is written on it should be underwritten.]

195

BROADCASTING ACT 1989

1989/132 – 8 June 1989

PART 1

PART 4

PRELIMINARY

FINANCIAL PROVISIONS

1

Short title

25

Capital

2

Interpretation

26

Bank accounts

3

Application

27

Application of funds

4

General objectives of the Act

28

Disposition of profits

29

Advances to Corporation

PART 2

30

Investment of excess funds

THE BROADCASTING CORPORATION

31

Annual estimates

5

The Corporation established

32

Accounts and records

6

Services of Corporation

33

Audit

7

Functions and powers of the Corporation

34

Annual report

8

Government policy

9

Programme functions and powers

PART 5

10

Board of Directors

PROGRAMMES

11

Term of office of appointed directors

35

Programme standards

12

Extraordinary vacancies

36

Advertisements

13

Chairman

14

Remuneration of directors

PART 6

15

Meetings of directors

MISCELLANEOUS

16

Leave of absence

37

Power to require certain transmissions

17

Disclosure of interests

38

Power of Corporation to charge fees

18

Directors not personally liable

39

Contracts for services and programmes

19

Contracts by the Corporation

40

Regulations

20

Committees

41

[Spent]

21

Delegation of powers

PART 7

PART 3

TRANSITIONAL PROVISIONS

PERSONNEL

42

[Spent]

22

General Manager

43

Personnel

23

Corporation employees

44

[Spent]

24

Public Service terms and conditions


196 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

To establish the Broadcasting Corporation of Niue for the provision of television and radio services and for related purposes

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Broadcasting Act 1989.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“advertisement” means any matter which draws the attention of the public,
or a segment thereof, to a product, service, person, organisation or line
of conduct in a manner which appears to be calculated to promote or
oppose, directly or indirectly, that product, service, person, organisation
or line of conduct;
“Board” means the Board of Directors appointed under this Act;
“broadcasting” means the transmission of sound and/or visual images
intended for direct reception by the general public;
“community announcement” means an advertisement relating to a
community event or activity or to public health or education;
“Corporation” means the Broadcasting Corporation of Niue established
by this Act;
“Minister” means the Minister for the time being in charge of broadcasting;
“programme” means any matter including an advertisement transmitted
as part of the Corporation’s television and/or radio services;
“radio service” means the service called Radio Sunshine established by
this Act;
“regulations” means regulations made under section 40;
“services” in addition to Radio Sunshine and Television Niue, includes
any other service established by the Corporation;
“television service” means the service called Television Niue established
by this Act.

3 Application

(1) This Act shall bind the Crown except as specified in this Act or the
regulations but nothing in this Act shall render the Crown liable to any prosecution.
(2) Except as otherwise provided, this Act shall be read subject to the
Communications Act 1989.
(3) Subject to this Act, the Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979 shall
not apply to the Corporation.

4 General objectives of the Act

The general objectives of this Act are –
(a) To provide for national broadcasting to be controlled by a
corporation which, subject to this Act, acts as a trustee of the national
interest and operates its services with the maximum independence;
(b) To provide a means of ensuring that television and radio
programmes are compatible with the identity and culture of Niue;
and
(c) To provide for the ultimate accountability of the broadcasting system
to the Niue Assembly through the Minister and Cabinet.

Broadcasting Act 1989

197
PART 2
THE BROADCASTING CORPORATION

5 The Corporation established

(1) There is hereby established a corporation to be called the Broadcasting
Corporation of Niue.
(2) The Corporation shall be a body corporate with perpetual succession
and a common seal, and shall be capable of acquiring, holding, and disposing of
real and personal property, of suing and being sued, and of doing and suffering
all such acts and things as bodies corporate may do and suffer.
(3) All courts, judges and persons acting judicially shall take judicial notice
of the imprint of the seal of the corporation appearing on a document and shall
presume that the document was duly sealed.

6 Services of Corporation

(1) The Corporation shall maintain the following services –
(a) The existing service called Radio Sunshine;
(b) The existing service called Television Niue;
(c) Such other services as the Corporation may from time to time
establish.
(2) Cabinet may, on the recommendation of the Corporation, approve the
disestablishment of any of the services mentioned in subsection (1) (a) and (b).

7 Functions and powers of the Corporation

(1) The functions of the Corporation are to provide national broadcasting
services for Niue and if so directed by Cabinet to places outside Niue, which –
(a) Serve as far as practicable, all the people of Niue;
(b) Contribute to the development of national unity;
(c) Preserve and stimulate pride in the indigenous culture and
traditions of the people of Niue; and
(d) Consist of a variety of programmes which inform, educate and
entertain.
(2) Subject to this Act the Corporation has power to do all things necessary
or convenient to be done for or in connection with the performance of its functions
and, in particular has power –
(a) To enter into contracts;
(b) To acquire, hold and dispose of real or personal property;
(c) To occupy, use and control any land or building owned or held
under lease by the State and made available for the purposes of the
Corporation;
(d) To erect buildings and structures and carry out works;
(e) To appoint agents and attorneys, and to act as agent for other
persons;
(f) To engage persons to perform services for the Corporation;
(g) To accept gifts, devises and bequests made to the Corporation,
whether on trust or otherwise, and to act as trustee of moneys or
other property vested in the Corporation on trust;
(h) To borrow money from any bank or lending institution (with or
without security) on such terms and conditions it may agree to;
and
(i) To do anything incidental to any of its powers.
(3) The Corporation shall not borrow any sums up to $20,000 without first
obtaining the Minister ’s concurrence, and further shall not borrow any sums of
more than $20,000 without first obtaining Cabinet’s approval.
198 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

8 Government policy

(1) In the exercise of its functions and powers the Corporation shall have
regard to the general policy of the Government in relation to broadcasting or to
the functions and powers of the Corporation as that policy is communicated to
the Corporation by Cabinet, and shall comply with any directions given by Cabinet
to the Corporation by notice in writing pursuant to any such policy.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) authorises Cabinet to give a direction in
respect of –
(a) A particular programme;
(b) The gathering or presentation of news or the preparation or
presentation of current affairs programmes;
(c) Contracts for the provision of programmes; or
(d) The staffing of the Corporation.

9 Programme functions and powers

The programme functions and powers of the Corporation shall be –
(a) To ensure that each Service operates as a public service to provide
and produce programmes which inform, educate, and entertain;
(b) To establish a system for the gathering of news for television, and a
system for the gathering of news for radio; and to make such news
available for the services;
(c) To negotiate for and purchase or otherwise acquire programmes,
and rights or privileges in respect of sports fixtures and other events,
occasions, meetings, functions, or incidents of public interest for
broadcast by the Services, and to establish procedures for the
allocation of such programmes, rights, or privileges to the Services;
(d) To conduct or commission a programme, audience research, market,
or technical surveys, which may be released to such persons and in
such manner and on such terms and conditions as the Corporation
thinks fit.

10 Board of Directors

(1) The Corporation shall be governed by a Board of Directors consisting
of the following Directors:
(a) Four persons appointed under subsection (2);
(b) The Financial Secretary ex officio;
(c) The Director of Community Affairs ex officio.
(2) The directors specified in subsection (1) (a) shall be appointed by
Cabinet as follows:
(a) One director to represent commercial interests;
(b) One director to represent youth interests;
(c) One director to represent religious interests;
(d) One director to represent women.
(3) No other person may be appointed under subsection (2) to be a director
or may continue to hold office as a director so appointed, while he is a person
holding a full time office of emolument in the Corporation.
(4) Without limiting the generality of the powers and functions of the
Corporation as provided under this Act, the Board shall –
(a) Ensure that the functions of the Corporation are performed
efficiently with the maximum benefit to the people of Niue;
(b) Maintain the independence and integrity of the Corporation subject
to this Act;

Broadcasting Act 1989

199
(c) Ensure that the assets of the Corporation are as far as practicable preserved, maintained and utilised in a manner consistent with the functions of the Corporation; and
(d) Ensure that the Corporation does not contravene or fail to comply with any of the provisions of this Act or any directions given under section 8.

11 Term of office of appointed directors

(1) Every director appointed under section 10 (2) shall be appointed for a
term of 2 years.
(2) Subject to section 12 every appointed director shall continue to hold
office until his successor comes into office.
(3) Every appointed director may be reappointed.

12 Extraordinary vacancies

(1) Any appointed director may at any time resign his office by notice in
writing delivered to the Clerk of Cabinet.
(2) Cabinet may remove any appointed director from office –
(a) For disability, neglect of duty, misconduct, or bankruptcy; or
(b) If the director has permanently left Niue; or
(c) If the director is absent from three consecutive meetings of the Board
without leave of absence from the Board as required under section
16.
(3) If an appointed director dies, or resigns, or is removed from office under
this section, the vacancy thereby occurring shall be deemed to be an extraordinary
vacancy, and may be filled by an appointment made in the same manner as that of
the director vacating office.
(4) Any person appointed to fill an extraordinary vacancy shall hold office
for the unexpired balance of the term of office of his predecessor, but may be
reappointed.
(5) The powers of the Board shall not be affected by any vacancy in its
membership.

13 Chairman

(1) Cabinet shall appoint one of the Directors specified under section 10
(1) (a) to be the Chairman of the Board.
(2) The Chairman shall hold office as such for a period of 3 years from the
date of his appointment unless he sooner ceases to be a director, and may be
reappointed as such.

14 Remuneration of directors

Every director shall be paid such fees as may be fixed by Cabinet by
regulations made under this Act.

15 Meeting of directors

(1) [Spent]
(2) Meetings of directors shall be held at least once every 2 months at such
times and places as the Chairman or the directors appoint.
(3) The Chairman shall call a meeting whenever required to do so in writing
by any 3 directors.
(4) At any meeting 5 directors shall form a quorum.
(5) The Chairman shall preside at every meeting at which he is present.
200 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(6) If the Chairman is for any reason absent from a meeting, the directors present shall elect one of their number to preside at that meeting.
(7) (a) In the absence from any meeting of a director ex officio, he may authorise any other officer of his department or (in the case of the General Manager) of the Corporation to attend the meeting in his place.
(b) Any officer so authorised shall be deemed for all purposes to be a director of the Corporation when he so attends that meeting.
(8) At every meeting the Chairman or other person presiding shall have a
deliberative vote and in the case of an equality of votes, he shall also have a casting
vote.
(9) Every question arising at a meeting shall be decided by a majority of the votes recorded on the question.
(10) Subject to this Act, the Board may regulate its procedure in such manner as it thinks fit.

16 Leave of absence

The Board may grant leave to a director to be absent from a meeting of the
Board upon such conditions as to remuneration or otherwise as the Board thinks
fit.

17 Disclosure of interests

(1) A director who has a direct or indirect pecuniary interest in a matter
being considered or about to be considered by the Board shall, as soon as possible
after the relevant facts have come to his knowledge, disclose the nature of his
interest at a meeting of the Board.
(2) A disclosure under subsection (1) shall be recorded in the minutes of
the meeting of the Board and the director shall not –
(a) Be present during any deliberation of the Board with respect to
that matter; or
(b) Take part in any decision of the Board with respect to that matter;
or
(c) In any way influence any decision of the Board.
(3) Notwithstanding subsection (2)(a), the director shall be counted as
present for the purpose of forming a quorum of the Board for any such deliberation
or decision.

18 Directors not personally liable

No director of the Corporation shall be personally liable for any act done
or default made by the Corporation or by any of its members in good faith in the
course of its operations.

19 Contracts by the Corporation

(1) Contracts on behalf of the Corporation may be made as follows –
(a) Any contract which, if made between private persons, must be by
deed shall, if made by the Corporation, be in writing under the
common seal of the Corporation;
(b) Any contract which, if made between private persons, must be in
writing signed by the parties to be charged therewith shall, if made
by the Corporation, be in writing either under the common seal of
the Corporation or signed by any person on behalf and by direction
(either general or specific) of the Corporation;

Broadcasting Act 1989

201
(c) Any contract which, if made between private persons may be made orally, may if made by the Corporation be made orally by any person on behalf and by direction (either general or specific) of the Corporation.
(2) So far as reasonably practicable contracts of the Corporation shall be made in writing.
(3) The common seal of the Corporation shall not be affixed to any document except in pursuance of a resolution of the Board and the execution of any document so sealed shall be attested by 2 directors.

20 Committees

(1) The Corporation may appoint committees consisting of any directors
of officers of the Corporation.
(2) Subject to this Act and to any directions given to it by the Corporation,
every committee may regulate its procedure in such manner as it thinks fit.

21 Delegation of powers

(1) The Corporation may delegate to any of its committees, or to the General
Manager, or to any other officer of the Corporation any of its powers under this
Act, including this present power of delegation.
(2) Subject to any general or specific directions given to it or to him by the
Corporation, any committee or person to whom any powers are so delegated may
exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same effect as if they had
been conferred on it or him directly by this Act and not by delegation.
(3) Any committee or person purporting to act under any delegation under
this section shall be presumed, until the contrary is proved, to be acting in
accordance with the terms of the delegation.
(4) Every such delegation shall be revocable at will, and no such delegation
shall prevent the exercise of any power by the Corporation itself.
(5) Until any such delegation is revoked, it shall continue in force according
to its tenor, notwithstanding any change in the membership of the Corporation or
of any committee.

22 General Manager

PART 3
PERSONNEL
(1) The Board, shall appoint a General Manager of the Corporation, for such period (not exceeding 2 years) as may be specified in the appointment, and on such terms and conditions as may be determined by the Board.
(2) (a) The General Manager shall be the administrative head of the Corporation, and shall be responsible to the Corporation for the effective and efficient execution of the Corporation’s functions.
(b) In carrying out his duties, he shall follow any general or special directions given to him by the Corporation.
(3) The General Manager may be reappointed.
(4) All remuneration and other allowances and expenses payable to the
General Manager shall be paid out of the funds of the Corporation.
(5) The General Manager shall not engage in any other business or
occupation.
202 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

23 Corporation employees

(1) The Corporation may employ such officers and employees as it
considers necessary for the performance of its functions, on such terms and
conditions as provided under section 24, and may at any time remove any such
officer or employee from his office or employment.
(2) For the purposes of article 62 of the Constitution the General Manager
and other employees of the Corporation shall not be regarded as members of the
Niue Public Service.

24 Public Service terms and conditions

(1) The Corporation shall, with any necessary modifications, apply the
terms and conditions applicable to the Niue Public Service, to the remuneration
and conditions of employment of the employees of the Corporation in the same
manner as they apply to the remuneration and conditions of employment of
employees in the Niue Public Service.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) the Corporation may, with the express
approval of Cabinet, apply to its employees terms and conditions more favourable
than those applicable to the Niue Public Service.

25 Capital

PART 4
FINANCIAL PROVISIONS
(1) The capital of the Corporation shall be $266,000 made up as follows – (a) As to the amount of $190,000 representing a book value of all the assets of Radio Sunshine and Television Niue as of 31 March 1989;
and
(b) A cash grant of $76,000 to be made by the Government of Niue to
the Corporation on the commencement of this Act.
(2) (a) The Corporation may by resolution and with the concurrence of
the Minister, recommend to Cabinet that the capital of the
Corporation be increased, and in any such case Cabinet, on the
advice of the Minister of Finance, may, by regulation increase the
capital of the Corporation to such amount as may be prescribed in
that regulation.
(b) The amount of any such increase shall be paid to the Corporation
by the Minister of Finance, from money appropriated by the
Assembly for that purpose.
(3) The whole of the capital of the Corporation for the time being shall be
deemed to be vested in the Crown.

26 Bank accounts

(1) The Corporation shall open and maintain an account with a bank
approved by the Board and shall pay to that account –
(a) All capital grants made under section 25 (1)(b);
(b) All advances made under section 29;
(c) All fees charged by the Corporation under section 38;
(d) All other money derived from the operations of the Corporation or
received by the Corporation from any source whatsoever.
(2) The bank account shall be operated upon only by cheque or other
instruments (not being a promissory note or bill) signed by such person or persons
as may be authorised by the Corporation for that purpose.

Broadcasting Act 1989

203

27 Application of funds

The funds of the Corporation shall be applied only –
(a) In payment or discharge of the expenses, charges, obligations, or
liabilities incurred or undertaken by the Corporation in or in
connection with the performance of its functions or the exercise of
its powers;
(b) In making any other payments that are required by law to be made
out of the funds of the Corporation.

28 Disposition of profits

(1) The Corporation shall establish a Reserve Fund into which shall be
paid the annual surplus of the Corporation.
(2) The annual surplus shall consist of so much of the annual income of
the Corporation as is not required for the payment of expenses, including staff,
salaries, and allowances; provision for previous losses, bad and doubtful debts;
depreciation of assets; and all such other matters as the Corporation considers
proper.
(3) [Spent]
(4) (a) During subsequent years the Corporation shall declare a dividend
on the capital of the Corporation of such amount as may be fixed in
that behalf by the Minister of Finance, after consultation by him
with the Corporation.
(b) The Minister of Finance, having regard to the financial position of
the Corporation, may in any financial year determine that no
dividend shall be payable by the Corporation in respect of that year.
(5) The amount of any dividend declared by the Corporation under this
section shall be paid into the Niue Government Account.

29 Advances to Corporation

(1) Cabinet may –
(a) Advance money to the Corporation; or
(b) Give in respect of any advance made to the Corporation by any
other person any guarantee, indemnity, or security on and subject
to such terms and conditions as Cabinet thinks fit.
(2) All money required to be paid by Cabinet under subsection (1)(a) shall
be paid out of the Niue Government Account as appropriated by the Assembly
for that purpose.
(3) Cabinet may enter into agreements with the Corporation for the
purposes of giving full effect to this section.

30 Investment of excess funds

Any excess funds of the Corporation may be invested on deposit in any
bank approved by the Board.

31 Annual estimates

(1) The Corporation shall, for each financial year, prepare an estimate in a
form approved by the Minister of Finance, of the amount of expenditure for all
purposes, and the receipts of the Corporation.
(2) The estimates so prepared shall be submitted to the Minister not later
than such date as the Minister directs, for the approval of such estimates by Cabinet,
and the funds of the Corporation shall not be expended otherwise than in
accordance with estimates of expenditure so approved.
204 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

32 Accounts and records

The Corporation shall cause to be kept proper accounts and records of the
transactions and affairs of the Corporation and shall do all things necessary to
ensure that all payments out of its funds are correctly made and properly authorised
and that adequate control is maintained over the assets of or in the custody of the
Corporation and over the incurring of liabilities by the Corporation.

33 Audit

The accounts and records of financial transactions of the Corporation shall
be audited annually by the Government Auditors and a report of the audit shall
be furnished to the Corporation and Cabinet.

34 Annual report

The Corporation shall within 3 months after the end of the Corporation’s
financial year prepare and furnish to the Minister a report on its operations during
the year ended on that date together with financial statements in respect of that
year in such form as the Minister of Finance approves.

35 Programme standards

PART 5
PROGRAMMES
(1) Subject to any advice that the Corporation may receive from the Programme Advisory Committee pursuant to section 13 of the Communications Act 1989, the Corporation shall be responsible for maintaining, in its programmes and their presentation, standards which will be generally acceptable in the community, and in particular it shall have regard to –
(a) The provision of a range of programmes which will cater in a
balanced way for the varied interests of different sections of the
community;
(b) The needs to ensure as far as practicable, that a Niuean identity is
developed and maintained in the services;
(c) The observance of standards of good taste and decency;
(d) The accurate and impartial gathering and presentation of news
according to recognised standards of objective journalism;
(e) The principle that when controversial issues of public importance
are discussed, reasonable efforts are made to present significant
points of view either in the same programme or in other
programmes within the period of current interest;
(f) The maintenance of law and order; and
(g) The privacy of the individual.
(2) In ensuring compliance with subsection (1)(c), the Corporation shall
be guided by such guidelines as are applied by the Censor of Films under the
Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979, notwithstanding section 3(3) of this Act.

36 Advertisements

(1) Notwithstanding section 12(1)(a) of the Communications Act 1989 the
Corporation shall be empowered to transmit advertisements through any of its
services.
(2) In making such transmissions the Corporation shall take into account
Cabinet’s policies on matters of advertising and shall further take into account
any guidelines established by the Programme Advisory Committee under section
13(5) of the Communications Act.

Broadcasting Act 1989

205
PART 6
MISCELLANEOUS

37 Power to require certain transmissions

(1) When required to do so by the Minister, the Corporation shall make
the service available to transmit any programme the Minister with Cabinet’s
approval, considers to be in the national interest.
(2) The Corporation shall not be obliged to make the service available under
subsection (1) for more than 1 hour in any one day.
(3) During any period of national emergency proclaimed under section 2
of the Public Emergency Act 1979 –
(a) The limitation referred to in subsection (2) shall not apply; and
(b) The Corporation shall make the service available to authorised
officers of the Government to transmit such matter as the Minister
with Cabinet’s approval, considers necessary.
(4) The power of the Minister under subsection (1) does not include the
power to require the Corporation to transmit any programme or other matter that
could reasonably be interpreted as promoting or opposing:
(a) A candidate in an election; or
(b) A particular point of view in relation to an issue or matter that is
being submitted to the electorate in an election.

38 Power of Corporation to charge fees

(1) The Corporation may recommend to Cabinet the level of fees that the
Corporation would charge for any of its services.
(2) The fees to be charged shall be set by Cabinet by regulations under
section 40.

39 Contracts for services and programmes

The Corporation may enter into such contracts and make such arrangements
as it thinks fit with any person who, subject to the terms and conditions of any
such contract or arrangement, will produce programmes or parts of programmes
to be broadcast by the Corporation.

40 Regulations

Cabinet may, on the recommendation of the Corporation, make regulations
necessary for carrying out or giving full effect to this Act.

41 [Spent]

42 [Spent]

PART 7
TRANSITIONAL PROVISIONS

43 Personnel

(1) (a) Notwithstanding sections 22 and 23 the Corporation may employ
the General Manager and other employees on a secondment basis
from the Niue Public Service, on such arrangements as agreed upon
with the Niue Public Service Commission.
(b) The Corporation shall have the sole discretion as to which
employees of the Niue Public Service are to be engaged on such
basis.

206 Niue Laws 2006 Voll

(2) During the term of such employment the General Manager and other staff shall come under the full control of the Corporation notwithstanding the continuance of their status as members of the Niue Public Service.

44 [Spent]

207

BUILDING CODE ACT 1992

1992/165 – 5 November 1992

21-22 [Spent]

To make provision for a code to regulate the construction of buildings in Niue

1 Short title

This is the Building Code Act 1992.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“building” means any or part of any structure or erection used or capable
of being used either –
(a) For human habitation;
(b) As a place within or under which work is performed;
(c) For storage of commodities articles or things,
and includes every other structure or erection associated with or having
the purpose of assisting or enhancing such habitation work or storage,
but does not include a structure or erection that is temporary having
regard to the materials from which it is constructed or the purpose for
which it shall be used;
“Building Inspector” means the Building Inspector appointed pursuant to
section 3;
“Code” means the National Building Code prescribed under section 4;
“construct” means to carrying out work (other than temporary work) that
shall have the purpose or effect of supporting adding to altering or
adapting the structure of a building and includes work carried out that
shall have the purpose or effect of supplying water or electricity to or
within a building;
“permit” means building permit issued under this Act.
208 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

3 Building Inspector, other inspectors, and delegation

(1) There shall be appointed as members of the Public Service, a Building
Inspector, and such other inspectors as may be required for the purpose of
administering this Act.
(2) The Building Inspector may either generally or particularly delegate to
any inspector, such of his powers as the Building Inspector may determine.
(3) Subject to this section and to any general or special directions given or
conditions attached by the Building Inspector, the inspector to whom any powers
are delegated under this section may exercise those powers in the same manner
and with the same effect as if they had been conferred on the inspector directly by
this section.
(4) Every inspector purporting to act under any delegation under this
section shall be presumed to be acting in accordance with the terms of the
delegation in the absence of proof to the contrary.
(5) Any delegation made under this section may be revoked by the Building
Inspector in whole or in part, and no such delegation shall prevent the exercise of
any power by the Building Inspector.

4 National Building Code

(1) There may be prescribed under section 5, standards and controls relating
to the construction of buildings and such standards and controls shall be known
as the National Building Code.
(2) The National Building Code shall apply to the construction of every
building.

5 Standards and controls

(1) Without limiting the generality of section 4 (1), Cabinet may prescribe
regulations for all or any of the following –
(a) The classification of buildings or parts of a building having regard
to the purpose for which the building is designed constructed or
used;
(b) The structural requirements of a building;
(c) The resistance and stability of a building in the event of fire;
(d) The access to and egress from a building including access and egress
by disabled persons, the provision of escape exits and the
construction of any means of access or egress;
(e) The provision of electricity to and within a building;
(f) The provision of fire fighting equipment and the control of smoke
in a building;
(g) The provision of amenities for the avoidance of health threatening
conditions;
(h) The weatherproofing, supply of water, plumbing, drainage
(including roof drainage) and sewage containment and its disposal;
(i) The provision of cooking and sanitary facilities;
(j) The size of rooms including their height and the provision of light
and ventilation;
(k) The minimum requirements of any of the matters referred to in
paragraphs (a) to (j).
(2) The National Building Code for Niue dated 1990 shall be deemed to be
regulations made under subsection (1).
(3) Cabinet may by regulation add to, delete from or amend any provision
of the Code.

Building Code Act 1992

209

6 Buildings to have permit

(1) No person shall commence or cause to be commenced the construction
of a building or engage in the construction of a building without a building permit
having first been applied for and issued under this Act.
(2) Every person who shall cause to be commenced the construction of a
building and every person engaged in the construction of a building in respect of
which a building permit is not issued in contravention of subsection (1), commits
an offence and upon conviction shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty
units.

7 Application for permit

(1) Every person intending to construct a building shall make application
to the Building Inspector for the issue of a permit in respect of the building to be
constructed.
(2) Every application under subsection (1) shall contain all such information
as the Building Inspector may reasonably require to ensure that the building
complies with the Code including –
(a) A site plan detailing –
(i) the location of the building and distance from each boundary
measured from the outer extremities of the building;
(ii) the distance from any existing building within the boundaries
of the site measured from the outer extremities of each building;
(iii) the width of any public road or access way adjacent to a
boundary;
(iv) the location of any water bore and its distance from any waste
disposal facility measured from the outer limits of such facility;
(v) the point at which electricity and water will be made available
to the site and the location of the means by which the building
shall be supplied;
(b) A design plan detailing –
(i) drawings of at least 4 elevations of the building;
(ii) drawings of at least one section of the building which shall
describe the stud height;
(iii) drawings describing the ties;
(c) Specifications;
(d) The dates upon which it is intended –
(i) that construction shall commence;
(ii) that the placement of foundations, and reinforcing studs shall
be completed;
(iii) the walls (without wall linings) and roof shall be completed;
(iv) fixing of wall linings shall commence;
(v) that construction shall be completed;
(e) The address at which the construction will take place;
(f) The name and address of the person who shall be the owner of the
building;
(g) The name and address of the person who shall be responsible for
the construction of the building, and the name and address of every
subcontractor.
(3) No application for a permit shall be granted by the Building Inspector
unless the information required under subsection (2) is submitted to the building
inspector and the building complies with the Code.
210 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(4) In approving the issue of a permit the Building Inspector may, subject to this Act and the Code –
(a) Require an existing building upon which construction work shall be undertaken and in respect of which work, a permit will issue, to comply with the Code to the extent that the work to be undertaken shall allow.
(b) Impose such reasonable terms and conditions that the Building
Inspector deems to ensure that the Code shall be complied with.
(5) Every applicant for a building permit, or where the applicant is absent
or unable to do so, the person who shall be responsible for the construction of the
building, shall notify the Building Inspector in writing of every deletion from or
addition to information contained in an application for a permit.
(6) Every person commits an offence who engages or who causes any other
person to be engaged in the construction of a building and the construction engaged
in is –
(a) Other than in accordance with information supplied to the building controller; and
(b) Without the prior written approval of the building inspector to the
variation of such information;
and upon conviction shall be liable to a fine of 5 penalty units.

8 Validity of permit

(1) Every permit issued under section 7 shall entitle the applicant to
commence or cause to be commenced the construction of the building in respect
of which it is issued and shall remain in force until the construction of the building
is completed consistent with the Code unless –
(a) Such construction is not commenced within the period of 12 months
from the date that the permit was issued, in which case the permit
shall upon the expiry of that period be cancelled under section 12;
or
(b) Construction of the building shall cease for a continuous period of
6 months, in which case the permit shall be cancelled under section
12; or
(c) The permit shall be suspended under section 11 in which case the
permit shall be of no effect during the period for which it is
suspended;
(d) The permit shall be cancelled under section 12 in which case the
permit shall be of no effect from the date that it is cancelled.

9 Inspection of building

(1) It shall be a condition of every permit that where the construction of a
building shall involve work to be inspected, then upon such work having been
undertaken no person engaged in the construction of the building shall undertake
any other work that shall have the effect of preventing the Building Ins ector
from carrying out a visual inspection of that work, until that inspection has actually
been carried out and the building inspector has determined in writing that the
other work may proceed to be undertaken.
(2) In respect of work to be inspected, it shall be the duty of every person
responsible for the construction of a building to –
(a) Notify the Building Inspector when such work may be inspected;
and
(b) Prohibit any work that shall have the effect of preventing such
inspection.

Building Code Act 1992

211
(3) Every person who shall engage in work contrary to subsection (1) and every person responsible for the construction of a building who shall contravene subsection (2) commits an offence and upon conviction shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.
(4) For the purpose of this Act, work to be inspected shall include –
(a) The footings and foundations (including steelwork) prior to the
pouring of concrete;
(b) The wall framing prior to the affixing of wall coverings;
(c) The roof framing prior to the affixing of ceilings or roofing.
(5) The Building Inspector may, at any reasonable time, enter upon any
land on which a building is being constructed and into any premises in respect of
which a building permit has been issued for the purposes of either –
(a) Determining whether a building permit has been issued under this
Act; or
(b) Ascertaining whether the provisions of this Act, the Code and any
permit are being complied with;
(c) Ensuring that the matters set out in any requisition issued under
section 10 are complied with.
(6) For the purposes of subsection (1), the Building Inspector may interview
any person who shall appear to him to be engaged in the construction of the
building and every person so interviewed shall, if within his knowledge, answer
all questions put to him by the Building Inspector.
(7) Every person who prevents, obstructs or misleads the Building Inspector
in the performance of his duties under this section, or who fails to answer any
question put to him under subsection (6), commits an offence and upon conviction
shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

10 Requisitions

(1) The Building Inspector may by requisition under his hand to the person
responsible for the construction of the building, set out with reasonable
particularity any matter that, in his opinion, does not comply with the Code of the
permit and may require the person responsible for the construction of the building
to remedy that inconsistency within a specified period not exceeding 3 months.
(2) Every person who shall be responsible for the construction of a building
and who shall be served with a requisition under subsection (1) shall undertake
or cause to be undertaken such work as shall be necessary to ensure that the matters
set out in the requisition are complied with.

11 Suspension of permit

(1) The Building Inspector may, suspend a permit where –
(a) The provisions of the Code are not being complied with; or
(b) The provisions of the permit are not being complied with; or
(c) The matters set out in a requisition have not been complied with
within the time specified in such requisition; or
(d) He is prevented by the owner of the building or his agents servants
workmen or employees or the person responsible for the
construction of the building from determining whether the
provisions of the Code or the permit are being complied with.
(2) Every permit that is suspended under subsection (1) shall remain
suspended until such time that –
(a) The person who shall be responsible for the construction of the
building causes such construction to comply with any requisition
or the provisions of the Code or permit; or
212 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) The building inspector is permitted to determine whether the provisions of the Code or the permit are being complied with and such determination has been made.
(3) Where a permit is suspended, no person shall, while the permit remains suspended, undertake, or cause to be undertaken any further construction of the building to which the permit relates other than that construction as shall be necessary to cause the building to comply with the requisition, the Code or the permit.
(4) Every person who contravenes subsection (3), commits an offence and
upon conviction shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

12 Cancellation of permit

(1) Subject to subsection (2), the Building Inspector shall cancel a permit
where –
(a) The construction of the building in respect of which the permit is issued is not commenced within 12 months of the date that the permit was issued; or
(b) The permit has been suspended and remains suspended for a
continuous period of 6 months for reasons within the control of the
owner of the building or the person responsible for the construction
of the building; or
(c) The construction of the building shall have ceased for a continuous
period of 6 months in circumstances indicating that the building to
which the permit applies is unlikely to be completed in accordance
with such permit.
(2) Every person who shall commence or cause to be commenced the
construction of a building or who shall engage in the construction of a building
after the permit in respect of that building has been cancelled commits an offence
and upon conviction shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

13 Notice of suspension or cancellation

(1) Every suspension of a permit and every cancellation of a permit under
this Act shall be notified to the applicant of the permit by personal service upon
the applicant of a notice to that effect.
(2) Where the applicant is beyond Niue, then service of the notice upon
the applicant shall be deemed to have been effected if the Building Inspector shall
cause to be delivered a copy of the notice to –
(a) the address at which the building is or was intended by the applicant
to be constructed; or
(b) the person who shall be responsible for the construction of the
building.

14 Appeals

(1) Every person who shall be affected by either a requisition issued under
section 10 or a notice of suspension or of cancellation under section 13, may, within
21 days of being served with a requisition or a notice, appeal to the High Court
against such requisition, suspension or cancellation setting out the grounds upon
which he is dissatisfied and the reasons therefor.
(2) The Court may on appeal confirm vary or annual any requisition, notice
or suspension or notice of cancellation.

Building Code Act 1992

213

15 Demolition order

(1) Where a person is charged with an offence under this Act the Court
may in addition to imposing any penalty that may be prescribed, but subject to subsection (2), order that the building or such part of a building as the Court shall define be removed taken down or demolished under the supervision of the building inspector.
(2) The Court shall not order the removal taking down or demolition of a building or any part of a building unless –
(a) The removal taking down or demolition will facilitate the Building
Inspector carrying out an inspection under section 9; or
(b) The building or the part of it to be removed taken down or
demolished poses a threat to human life; or
(c) The building or the part of it to be removed taken down or
demolished poses a threat to human health or health.

16 Offences

(1) Every person who shall contravene this Act for which no penalty is
prescribed commits an offence and upon conviction shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding . . . .
(2) Where the High Court shall impose a fine for the breach of this Act it
may in addition to imposing such fine order that the person convicted pay a sum
not exceeding . . . . for each day that the offence shall continue after the date that
the conviction shall be entered.

17 Jurisdiction of Commissioners

Three Commissioners of the Court sitting together shall have all jurisdiction
to hear and determine any proceedings under this Act and may hear and determine
any appeal under section 12.

18 Jurisdiction of Court with respect to dangerous deserted, ruinous and dilapidated buildings

(1) Upon being satisfied that any building is either –
(a) In such a condition to be dangerous to persons therein or in any
adjoining building or on any adjoining land or to passers-by; or
(b) In a dilapidated or ruinous condition and is being used in a
disorderly manner so as to be obnoxious to the neighbouring
inhabitants or to the public; or
(c) In a dilapidated and ruinous condition and in the case of a dwelling
house, had not been inhabited by or with the authority of the owner
for 12 months or more;
the Court may, upon application of the Building Inspector and after not less than
3 month’s notice of such application has been given to the owner of the building,
order the building to be secured or taken down, or as the case may be, repaired or
taken down as the Court thinks fit, within a time to be specified in the order.
(2) Every order requiring the building to be secured or repaired shall specify
the manner in which the building shall be so secured or repaired.
(3) If the order is not obeyed, the Building Inspector may cause the building
to be secured or taken down or repaired in compliance with the order.
(4) The building inspector may recover from the owner the cost of securing
or taking down or repairing any building under this section, together with all
expenses incurred by the Building Inspector under this section.
214 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(5) Any such notice or order to the owner may, in the absence of the owner, be given by being posted by registered letter addressed to him at his last known address, or by being served upon his agent or upon the occupier (if any) of the building, or, if the owner ’s address is not known and he has no known agent and the building is unoccupied, by fixing the notice or order on the building.
(6) Any such notice to any other person having an interest in the land may
be given to him by serving the notice upon him personally or by posting it by
registered letter addressed to him at his last known address or by serving it upon
his agent.
(7) If the building is taken down by the Building Inspector, he may destroy
or sell the materials or any part thereof, and apply the proceeds in or towards
payment of the expenses incurred under this section, and shall apply the residue
(if any) in payment of any registered encumbrances on the land in the order of
their priority, and shall upon demand pay the balance (if any) to the owner.

19 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations necessary or expedient for giving effect to
this Act and its administration including regulations providing for –
(a) The form and content of documentation required for the purpose
of this Act;
(b) The fees that may be charged for receiving an application or granting
any approval;
(c) The reimbursement of costs and expenses incurred by the building
inspector in having an application assessed to ensure that the Code
is complied with.

20 Act to bind Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.

21-22 [Spent]

215

BUSINESS LICENCE ACT 1997

1997/216 – 1 April 1997

1

Short title

2

Interpretation

3

Administration

4

Foreign enterprises and foreign interests

5

Act not to apply

6

Act not to bind

7

Prohibitions

8

Applications for licence

9

Advertising new applications

10

Receipt of applications

11

Issue of licence

12

Refusal of licence

13

Duration of licence

14

Renewal of licence

29-30 [Spent]

1 Short title

This is the Business Licence Act 1997.

2 Interpretation

In this Act and any regulations made under it –
“business” includes any profession, occupation, or commercial trade,
carried on for the purposes of making, or acquiring a commercial profit,
or commercial gain but, does not include:
(a) The profession, occupation, or function of any person employed as
a servant of the Crown;
(b) The profession of a bona fide minister of religion;
“business person” means –
(a) Any person, or body of persons whether corporate, or unincorporate
engaging in, or carrying on a business;
(b) The agent of a business person (other than an employee) engaged
in carrying on business on behalf of the business person;
“business premises” means any area of land, house, building, place, vehicle,
boat, ship, vessel or aircraft where any business person engages in, or
carries on any business;
“foreign enterprises” and “foreign interest” has the same meaning as under
the Development Investment Act 1992;
Gazette” means the Gazette, or any other periodic publication printed and
available on Niue;
“goods” means any form of tangible moveable property excluding those
things attached to and forming part of the land unless such things are
to be severed from the land for the purposes of sale;
216 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“hawker” includes any person who, carrying goods, regularly travels to any place in which he does not usually reside and there sells any of those goods;
“licence” means a licence duly issued under section 11 and in force under this Act;
“Licensor” means the Financial Secretary or his appointed agent;
“prescribed fee” means the fee prescribed in the Business Licence
Regulations;
“public show” means an event that takes place on open ground to which
the general public has access whether or not an entrance fee is payable;
“retail business” means a business carried on by a retailer;
“retailer” means any person whose business it is to sell goods to the public
generally, or to any class, or section of the public;
“sale” means a transfer of goods from one person to another inconsideration
of a price paid in money and shall include the bartering, or exchanging
of goods;
“service business” means the business carried on by a service provider;
“service provider” means any person the principle object of whose business
it is to provide services to the public generally, or to any class or section
of the public;
“stall” means a makeshift table and its immediate surrounds from which
goods are sold on any one day;
“wholesale business” means the business of selling goods only to licensed
retailers.

3 Administration

Subject to section 4, this Act shall be administered by the Licensor.

4 Foreign enterprises and foreign interests

This Act shall be subject to the Development Investment Act 1992, in regard
to all foreign enterprises and foreign interests.

5 Act not to apply

(1) This Act shall not apply to any person who carries on the business of
selling goods solely from –
(a) a ‘stall’; or
(b) the ‘makete’ (market) situate at Alofi.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection 1(a) and (b) this Act shall not apply to any
person carrying on the business of a hawker.

6 Act not to bind

This Act shall apply to corporate bodies in which the Crown has a
shareholding, or bodies incorporated by Act of the Assembly but, shall not apply
to the Crown.

7 Prohibitions

(1) Subject to section 5 no person shall directly, or indirectly engage in or
carry on any business unless a licence has first been obtained, provided however,
it shall be lawful for the spouse, child or servant of a licensed business person to
engage in, or carry on the business of that licensed business person.
(2) No licence shall be capable of being transferred, assigned, made the

Business Licence Act 1997

217
subject of any security, or otherwise dealt with but, shall be strictly personal to the business person to whom it has been issued, provided however, where a licenced business person dies, or becomes a person of unsound mind, or becomes bankrupt, or insolvent, the licence held by such business person shall ensure in favour of his personal representative, trustee, or other persons entitled to administer his estate or control his affairs.
(3) It shall be unlawful for any licensed business person to engage in, or carry on any business
(a) Other than that business stated in the licence; or
(b) At a place other than that place stated in the licence; or
(c) Contrary to any terms and conditions of the licence.

8 Applications for licence

(1) Any person desiring to carry on any business shall make application to
the Licensor for a licence to carry on the business.
(2) Each such application shall be delivered to the Licensor in the form
prescribed and shall specify:
(a) The full name, occupation and address in Niue of the applicant;
(b) Whether the applicant intends his business to be that of a –
(i) sole operator;
(ii) partnership;
(iii) family business;
(iv) duly incorporated company;
(c) The precise nature of the business for which the licence is sought;
(d) The type of licence sought, namely;
(i) a wholesaler ’s licence;
(ii) a retailer ’s licence;
(iii) a service provider ’s licence;
(e) Each business premise at, in, or from which, the applicant desires,
or intends to engage in, or carry on the business;
(f) The opening and closing hours of the business for which, approval
is sought;
(g) All other permits required to operate the business.
(3) Each such application shall be dated and signed by the applicant, or by
his duly authorised agent.
(4) Every such application shall be accompanied by the prescribed
application fee.
(5) Any applicant who knowingly and wilfully makes any false, or
misleading statement in any such application commits an offence and on conviction
shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

9 Advertising new applications

(1) The Licensor shall advertise all new applications for a business licence
seeking any objections to the proposed business licence.
(2) The advertisement is to be published in the Gazette and broadcast over
local radio and local television informing the public of:
(a) The name of the person seeking the licence;
(b) The nature of the business, and
(c) The location of the business stated in the business application.
(3) Any objections shall be in writing and delivered to the Licensor within
10 working days of the notice being published, or broadcast.
(4) No objection shall be considered if not received within the 10 working
days specified in subsection (3).
218 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

10 Receipt of applications

(1) Upon expiry of the 10 working days referred to in section 9(3) the
Licensor shall upon payment of the prescribed fee issued to the applicant a licence
in the prescribed form within a period not exceeding 10 days.
(2) The Licence may be subject to such reasonable conditions considered,
by the Licensor necessary to achieve orderly and balanced business activity
throughout Niue.
(3) The licence shall state –
(a) The full name of the applicant;
(b) The type of business;
(c) The place of business;
(d) Any conditions imposed by the Licensor.

11 Issue of licence

Every licence shall have a registered number endorsed on it and on the
issue of any licence, the Licensor shall forthwith deliver the licence to the business
person named.

12 Refusal of licence

(1) The Licensor may refuse to grant, or renew a licence if he is reasonably
of the opinion –
(a) The applicant is not a fit, or proper person to hold such a licence; or
(b) The issue of the licence would cause harm, or annoyance to the
residents of any locality on Niue; or
(c) The issue of the licence would result in a serious imbalance in the
particular market the applicant intends to operate having regard
to–
(i) objections made under section 9(3);
(ii) any market analysis made, or required by the Licensor.
(2) Upon refusal of a licence, the Licensor shall forthwith, by written notice
inform the applicant of such refusal together with the grounds for refusal.
(3) The Licensor shall deliver the written notice of refusal to the applicant.

13 Duration of licence

Every licence shall expire on 31 March, unless the licence shall be renewed
under section 14.

14 Renewal of licence

(1) At any time during the month of March, a business person may renew
his licence by delivering to the Licensor an application form in writing for the
renewal of the licence.
(2) Each such application for renewal shall specify:
(a) The number of the licences to be renewed; and
(b) The full name, occupation and address in Niue of the applicant;
and
(c) Any change in the matters set out in section 10 (3).
(3) Each such application shall be dated and signed by the applicant, or by
his duly authorised agent and shall be accompanied by the prescribed fee.
(4) On receipt of any such application for renewal together with the
prescribed fee, by the Licensor, the licence shall be renewed for a period of one
year commencing on 1 April, provided however, the Licensor may refuse to renew
the licence if he is reasonably satisfied that the applicant is no longer a fit and
proper person to hold a licence.

Business Licence Act 1997

219
(5) In the event of refusing to renew a licence, the Licensor shall within 7 days of the refusal, deliver a notice to the applicant for renewal, advising of the refusal.
(6) On receipt by the applicant for renewal of a notice from the Licensor refusing to renew a licence, such licence shall forthwith be revoked.
(7) On the renewal of any licence under subsection (4), the Licensor shall
issue and deliver a certificate of renewal to the business person named in the
certificate.
(8) One month prior to 31 March the Licensor shall insert a notice in the
local newspaper and broadcast such notice over the local radio and television
reminding persons to renew their business licence.

15 Licence to be exhibited

(1) A licensed business person shall exhibit his current business licence in
a conspicuous position, visible to members of the public at, in, or upon each of his
business premises, respectively at, in, or from which, he carries on the business
stated in his licence.
(2) It shall be permissible for a true copy of a current business certificate to
be exhibited, provided however, the true copy is a true copy issued under section
16.
(3) Any licensed business person who fails to comply with subsection (1) commits an offence and on conviction shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

16 Copies

(1) On paying the prescribed fee to the Licensor the licensed business
person shall be entitled to receive from the Licensor a true copy of any licence, or
any certificate of renewal of any licence issued to, or held by such business person.
(2) Each such copy shall be marked “true copy” and shall have the same
effect as the original document.

17 Fees

(1) Fees shall be payable as prescribed in the Business Licence Regulations.
(2) The Licensor, or any person duly authorised to act on his behalf, shall
issue an official Government receipt in respect of each fee received.
(3) All fees paid under this Act shall be paid into and shall form part of the
general revenue of the Government.

18 Delivery of documents

(1) Any applications, or objections required by this Act to be made to the
Licensor shall be in writing and delivered;
(a) Personally to the office of the Licensor; or
(b) By post.
(2) Any licence, or notice required by this Act to be delivered by the Licensor
to any person shall be in writing and delivered –
(a) Personally to that person; or
(b) By post to that person’s address stated on the licence.
(3) Any document despatched by post shall be deemed to have been
received on the date upon which, in the normal course of post it would have been
delivered.
220 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

19 A licensed wholesaler

(1) A licensed wholesaler shall be entitled to engage in, or carry on a
wholesale business in respect of the goods for which, he is licensed to carry on a
wholesale business provider however, he sells only to a licensed retailer and, or a
licensed service provided.
(2) Records of all business sales and purchases shall be kept.

20 A licensed retailer

(1) A licensed retailer shall be entitled to sell goods to the public.
(2) A record of all business sales and local purchases shall be kept.

21 A licensed service provider

(1) A licensed service provider shall be entitled to offer services to the public
from his business premises.
(2) If goods are sold without the provision of a service then a retailers license
shall also be required.
(3) A record of all business services provided and business purchases made,
shall be kept.

22 Register of licences

(1) The Licensor shall keep, in a convenient form, a Register of Licences
which, shall consist of a duplicate of all licenses, certificates of renewal of licence,
notices of refusal to renew licence and of any orders made by the Court, under
this Act relating to any licence.
(2) Each such duplicate shall be marked “duplicate” and shall have the
same evidential value as the original.
(3) Any person may between 10am and 3pm on any day except a Saturday,
or Public Holiday inspect such Register of Licences.

23 Business premises

(1) The Licensor, or any other person authorised in writing so to do by the
Licensor, or any constable may at any time between the hours of 9am and 4pm on
any day, not being a Saturday, or holiday, enter upon any business premise for the
purpose of carrying out an inspection of it.
(2) When carrying out such an inspection of the business premises, entry
to any private property shall not be permitted without the consent of the occupier
of it and, in the absence of any such consent, the prior consent of the Court.
(3) Should the requirements specified in any such notice not be carried
out, or put into effect within the period of time stipulated in such notice then,
upon the expiration of such period, no person thereafter shall be entitled to carry
on business at, in, or from the premises concerned without the prior written
conditional or unconditional consent of the Licensor, until such time as such
requirements shall have been carried out, or put into effect.
(4) Nothing in this section shall derogate, or be deemed to derogate from
the Public Health Act 1965.

24 Appeals to the Court

(1) Any applicant for a licence may appeal to the High Court against the
failure, or refusal of the Licensor to issue the licence sought by the applicant.
(2) Any applicant for the renewal of a licence may appeal to the Court
against a decision of the Licensor not to renew the licence.
(3) Any applicant for a licence to whom a licence has been issued may

Business Licence Act 1997

221
appeal to the Court against any condition imposed by the Licensor in respect of the licence.
(4) Where the Licensor has issued any licence (not being a renewal of a licence) any person aggrieved at the issue of the licence may appeal to the Court.

25 Time for making appeals

(1) Any such appeal under section 23 shall, subject to subsection (2) not be
made after the expiration of 2 weeks after the effective date of the act, ruling,
refusal, notice or decision which is the subject matter of the appeal.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1), the Court may if it thinks it just and
equitable to do so extend, or enlarge by not more than 2 months and either
unconditionally, or subject to such conditions which, it may think fit to impose,
the period of time within which any such appeal shall be made.

26 Powers of the Court

(1) On the hearing of any appeal bought in accordance with sections 24
and 23, the Court may, by order –
(a) Dismiss the appeal; or
(b) Allow the appeal; or
(c) Dismiss the appeal in part and allow it in part; or,
(d) Modify, vary, or amend the act, ruling, refusal, notice, or decision
which is the subject matter of the appeal in such manner and to
such an extent which the Court thinks just.
(2) Any such appeal shall be final.

27 Offences

(1) Subject to subsection (2) any person who engages in, or carries on any
business contrary to this Act commits an offence and on conviction shall be liable –
(a) For a first offence, to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units;
(b) For a second, or a subsequent offence, to a fine not exceeding 10
penalty units, or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 20 days,
or to both such a fine and such imprisonment.
(2) Nothing contained in subsection (1) shall derogate from section 8 (5) or
section 15 (2).
(3) Any person who buys any goods from any wholesaler, or retailer who
is not licensed, or gives any reward for any services provided by any service
provider, who is not licensed, knowing that such wholesaler, retailer, or service
provider should be licensed, commits an offence and on conviction shall be liable
to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

28 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations as may be deemed necessary, or expedient
to give full effect to this Act and to regulate licence fees and any other matters
required in the administration of this Act.

29-30 [Spent]

222 Niue Laws 2006 Vall

223

CARRIAGE BY AIR ACT 1967

1967/151 (NZ) – 24 November 1967

16-44 [Repealed]

45 [Spent]

SCHEDULES

To give effect to the provisions of a Convention concerning international carriage by air known as the Warsaw Convention as amended and supplemented by a subsequent Protocol and Convention, and to make provision with respect to carriage by air which is not international

1 Short title

This is the Carriage by Air Act 1967.

2 Act to bind Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.

3 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 1
INTERNATIONAL CARRIAGE BY AIR

4 [Repealed by 2004/270]

5 Interpretation

In this Part –
“Amended Convention” means the Convention set out in Schedule 1, being
the Warsaw Convention as amended by a Protocol opened for signature
at The Hague on 28 September 1955;
“court” includes (in an arbitration allowed by the amended Convention or
the Guadalajara Convention) an arbitrator;
“Guadalajara Convention” means the Convention set out in Schedule 2
being a Convention, supplementary to the Warsaw Convention, for the
unification of certain rules relating to international carriage by air
performed by a person other than the contracting carrier, opened for
signature at Guadalajara on 18 September 1961;
224 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“Warsaw Convention” means the Convention for the unification of certain rules relating to international carriage by air opened for signature at Warsaw on 12 October 1929 and includes the Additional Protocol to that Convention.

6 Application of Guadalajara Convention

In this Part references to the amended Convention or to any Article of that
Convention include, where applicable and subject to any necessary modifications,
references to that Convention or article as supplemented by the Guadalajara
Convention.

7 Conventions to have force of law

(1) The amended Convention and the Guadalajara Convention shall, so
far as they relate to the rights and liabilities of carriers, carriers’ servants and agents,
passengers, consignors, consignees, and other persons, and subject to this Part,
have the force of law in Niue in relation to any carriage by air to which the amended
Convention or the Guadalajara Convention, as the case may require, applies,
irrespective of the nationality of the aircraft performing that carriage.
(2) If there is any inconsistency between the text in English of the amended
Convention in Part 1 of Schedule 1 or the text of English of the Guadalajara
Convention in Part 1 of Schedule 2 and the corresponding text in French of those
Conventions in Part 2 of each of those Schedules, the text in French shall prevail.

8 Designation of Parties

(1) The Governor-General may, by Order in Council, certify who are the
High Contracting Parties to the amended Convention and the Parties to the
Guadalajara Convention, in respect of what territories they are respectively parties,
and to what extent they have availed themselves of the Additional Protocol at the
end of the amended Convention as set out in Schedule 1.
(2) Article 40A (2) of the amended Convention shall not be read as
extending references in the amended Convention to the territory of a High
Contracting Party (except such as are references to the territory of any State,
whether a High Contracting Party or not) to include any territory in respect of
which that High Contracting Party is not a party.
(3) An Order in Council shall, except so far as it has been superseded by a
subsequent Order, be sufficient evidence of the matters so certified.
(4) An Order in Council may contain such transitional and other
consequential provisions as appear to the Governor-General to be expedient.
(5) An Order in Council certifying who are the High Contracting Parties
to the amended Convention or the Parties to the Guadalajara Convention shall
specify the date on and from which any such Party became or ceased to be a Party.

9 Fatal accidents

References in section 4 of the Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952
to a wrongful act, neglect, or default shall include references to any occurrence
which gives rise to a liability under article 17 of the amended Convention.

10 Limitation of liability

(1) The limitations on liability referred to in article 22 of the amended
Convention shall apply whatever the nature of the proceedings by which liability
may be enforced and, in particular –

Carriage by Air Act 1967

225
(a) Those limitations shall apply where proceedings are brought by a tortfeasor to obtain a contribution from another tortfeasor if the tortfeasor from whom contribution is sought is the carrier or a servant or agent of the carrier; and
(b) The limitation for each passenger referred to the said article 22 (1) shall apply to the aggregate liability of the carrier in all proceedings which may be brought against him under the law of Niue together with any proceedings brought against him outside Niue.
(2) A court before which proceedings are brought to enforce a liability
which is limited by the said article 22 may at any stage of the proceedings make
any such order as appears to the court to be just and equitable in view of the said
article 22, and of any other proceedings which have been, or are likely to be,
commenced in Niue or elsewhere to enforce the liability in whole or in part.
(3) Without prejudice to subsection (2), a court before which proceedings
are brought to enforce a liability which is limited by the said article 22 shall, where
the liability is, or may be, partly enforceable in other proceedings in Niue or
elsewhere, have jurisdiction to award an amount less than the court would have
awarded if the limitation applied solely to the proceedings before the court, or to
make any part of its award conditional on the result of any other proceedings.
(4) The Minister of Finance may by notice in the Gazette, specify the
respective amounts which for the purposes of the said article 22, and in particular
of article 22 (5), are to be taken as equivalent to the sums expressed in francs
which are mentioned in that article.
(5) References in this section to article 22 include, subject to any necessary
modifications and as the case may require, references to that article as applied or
supplemented by article 25A of the amended Convention and articles 5 and 6 of
the Guadalajara Convention.

11 Time for bringing proceedings

(1) No action against a carrier ’s servant or agent which arises out of damage
to which this Part relates shall, if he was acting within the scope of his employment,
be brought after more than 2 years, reckoned from the date of arrival at the
destination, or from the date on which the aircraft ought to have arrived, or from
the date on which the carriage stopped.
(2) Article 29 of the amended Convention shall not be read as applying to
any proceedings for contributions between tortfeasors, but no action shall be
brought by a tortfeasor to obtain a contribution from a carrier in respect of a tort
to which the said article 29 applies after the expiration of 2 years from the time
when judgment is obtained against the person seeking to obtain the contribution.
(3) Subsections (1) and (2) and the said article 29 shall have effect as if
references in those provisions to an action included references to an arbitration;
and section 29 (3) and (4) of the Limitation Act 1950 (NZ) (which determines the
time at which an arbitration is deemed to have commenced) shall apply.

12 Contributory negligence

For the purposes of article 21 of the amended Convention section 736 of
the Niue Act 1966 shall be the law under which a court may exonerate the carrier
or partly from his liability.
226 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

13 Power to exclude aircraft in use for military purposes

(1) The Cabinet may by regulation, direct that this section shall apply, or
shall cease to apply, to Niue or any other State specified in the Regulation.
(2) The amended Convention shall not apply to the carriage of persons,
cargo, and baggage for the military authorities of a State to which this section
applies in aircraft registered in that State if the whole capacity of the aircraft has
been reserved by, or on behalf of, those authorities.

14 Actions against High Contracting Parties

Every High Contracting Party to the amended Convention who has not
availed himself of the provisions of the Additional Protocol at the end of the
amended Convention as set out in Schedule 1 shall, for the purposes of any action
brought in a court in Niue under article 28 of the amended Convention or article
8 of the Guadalajara Convention to enforce a claim in respect of carriage undertaken
by him, be deemed to have submitted to the jurisdiction of that court, and
accordingly rules of court may provide for the manner in which any such action is
to be commenced and carried on; but nothing in this section shall authorise the
issue of execution against the property of any High Contracting Party.

15 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as it thinks fit for the purposes of this
Act.

16-44 [Repealed by 2004/270]

45 [Spent]


SCHEDULES
[The Schedules are not reproduced. Hard copy is available in Niue Legislation as

1 August 1990, volume 1, pg 233. The Warsaw Convention and the Guadalajara

Convention are available on line at:
http://www.icao.int/eshop/conventions_list.htm]
227

CENSUS ACT 1971

1971/68 – 28 April 1971

1 Short title 11 Duty of inmates of dwelling

2 Interpretation 12 Objection to stating religion

3 Census of population 13 Census employees may ask questions

4 Census Officer 14 Additional instructions

5 Enumerators and agents 15 Neglect or refusal to supply particulars and

6 Attestation false particulars

7 Schedules 16 Mutilation or defacement of schedules

8 Particulars to be collected at census of 17 Divulging information

population 18 Hindering census employee

9 Census to be taken by means of schedules 19 Preparation of statistics

10 Duty of head of household or occupier or 20 [Spent]

person in charge of dwelling

To provide for the taking of the census of population

1 Short title

This is the Census Act 1971.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“census employee” means any person employed by the Census Officer
under section 5;
“Census Officer” means the Census Officer appointed under section 4;
“dwelling or household” means any building, construction, or erection,
whether permanent or temporary, which is wholly or partly used for
human habitation; and includes a ship or aeroplane;
“night of the census” means that night between sunset on the day before
and sunrise on the day appointed under this Act for the taking of the
census; the precise time reference being midnight of that night;
“head of household” or “occupier” or “person in charge” includes, as the
case may be, the person for the time being in charge of any dwelling, or
habitation attached to or used in a factory, plantation, workshop, office,
shop or other place of business, penal institution, hospital, or other
public charitable institution; and also includes the master of any ship
or vessel, the person in command of an aircraft, and the person in charge
of any vehicle; and where the occupier or person in charge is a corporate
body, includes the manager, secretary, clerk, or other executive officer
of the corporate body or local authority, or any person actually in charge
on behalf of the corporate body;
228 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“schedule” means any book, document, form, or card on which the information required is entered or indicated for statistical purposes under this Act.

3 Census of population

(1) The census of population of Niue shall be taken in 1971 and in every
fifth year thereafter.
(2) The day on which the census shall be taken and the time with reference
to which the particulars shall relate shall be appointed by the Secretary to the
Government by notice published in the Gazette.

4 Census Officer

(1) There shall be appointed, under Part 6 of the Niue Constitution, a
Census Officer for the proper carrying out of the provisions of this Act.
(2) Any person so appointed may hold office in addition to or in conjunction
with any office in the Niue Public Service.
(3) Any person so appointed shall be empowered to carry out any of the
functions or duties of a census enumerator or census employee.

5 Enumerators and agents

(1) The Census Officer may employ such enumerators, sub-enumerators,
agents, clerks, office assistants or other persons as may be necessary for the taking
of a census, and the duties of those employees shall be such as the Census Officer
determines.
(2) No person appointed under subsection (1) shall be deemed by reason
of his appointment under this section only, to be employed in the service of the
Government of Niue for the purpose of Part 6 of the Constitution.

6 Attestation

(1) Every person appointed for the purpose of taking the census, before
entering on his duties, shall take and subscribe to the following oath:
“I , solemnly swear that I will faithfully and honestly fulfil my duties as
in conformity with the requirements of the Census Act
1971, and that I will not, without due authority in that behalf, disclose or
make known any matter or thing which comes to my knowledge by reason
of my employment as such.”
(2) The oath shall be taken before the Census Officer and returned and
recorded as such Officer determines.

7 Schedules

The Census Officer shall, with the approval of the Cabinet, design and have
prepared for use such census and other schedules as he deems requisite for
collecting the statistics authorised to be collected, and shall lay down for all such
schedules the instructions and procedures necessary for the proper distribution,
filling in, and return of it.

8 Particulars to be collected at census of population

(1) At every census of population particulars relating to all of the following
matters shall be obtained by means of schedules from every occupant or as the
case may be from each person who is in charge of a dwelling –

Census Act 1971

229
(a) The name, sex, age, and ethnic origin of every occupant of the dwelling;
(b) Particulars of the dwelling as to location, number of rooms, ownership, and number of occupants on census night.
(2) At any census of population the Cabinet may, if it considers it in the public interest so to do, require the Census Officer to obtain from each or every occupant or as the case may be from each head of household or person in charge of a dwelling particulars relating to all or any of the following matters –
(a) The profession or occupation and industry in which employed,
nationality and citizenship, health, marital status, religion,
birthplace, duration of residence in Niue, number of children,
number of hours worked per week for wages or salary or financial
reward, status in employment, name of employer, income, usual
residence of every occupant of the dwelling;
(b) Particulars of the dwelling as to type of dwelling, household
amenities, material of walls and tenure of site;
(c) (i) Population and dwellings, migration (internal and external),
vital and other demographic and social matters;
(ii) Health, welfare, and morbidity;
(iii) Cultural participation, education, and recreation;
(iv) Law enforcement and the administration of justice;
(v) Matters relating to the social and physical environment;
(vi) Labour and manpower, including conditions of employment;
work descriptions; wages, including direct and indirect
emoluments; hours of work and labour disputes;
(vii) Accidents, including industrial injuries;
(viii) Household (including family) characteristics, conditions, and
activities;
(ix) Assets (including savings), liabilities and wealth of persons,
and undertakings;
(x) Prices of commodities and services at any or all transaction
levels;
(xi) Travel, internal and overseas;
(xii) Economic, financial, production, and other matters relating to
undertakings; forestry, fishing, trapping; agriculture; mines,
quarries, and wells; manufacturing; construction;
transportation, storage, and communications; electric power,
gas, and water utilities; wholesale and retail trade; finance,
insurance, and real estate; restaurants; hotels and
accommodation; and other community, business, welfare, and
personal services.

9 Census to be taken by means of schedules

The census shall be taken by means of the schedules referred to in sections
7 and 8 and containing particulars which shall be furnished by each head of household or occupant or person who resided in the dwelling on the night of the census and who was alive at midnight or who, not already being included in any other census schedule, arrived in that dwelling after midnight of the night of the census and before midnight on the next following night.
230 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

10 Duty of head of household or occupier or person in charge of dwelling The head of household or occupier or person in charge of every such dwelling shall ensure that the particulars required by the schedules are furnished

with respect to –
(a) Every person who resided in the dwelling on the night of the census
and was alive at midnight; and
(b) Every person who arrived at the dwelling after midnight on that
night and before midnight on the next following night and was not
included in any other census schedule.

11 Duty of inmates of dwelling

(1) Every person in respect of whom particulars are required under section
10 –
(a) Shall where necessary furnish such information as the head of household or occupier or person in charge of the dwelling may require so that he may complete the dwelling schedule; and
(b) Shall either complete a personal schedule and deliver it to the head of household or occupier or person in charge, or shall furnish the required particulars to the head of household or occupier or person in charge so that the latter can complete the personal schedule for him.
(2) (a) The person completing a personal schedule may enclose it in an envelope endorsed with his name and sex, and seal the envelope before delivery to the head of household or occupier or person in charge pending collection by the census employee.
(b) If the head of household or occupier or person in charge opens any such envelope he commits an offence and is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

12 Objection to stating religion

If any person objects to stating his religion, an entry of “object” made in the
space provided for the answer to this question in the personal schedule shall be
sufficient for the purposes of the census.

13 Census employees may ask questions

Every census employee appointed for the purpose of the census may ask
such questions and conduct such inquiries as are necessary to obtain or to verify
the particulars authorised by this Act to be collected.

14 Additional instructions

In any case in which the prescription of particulars hereinbefore specified
is insufficient to indicate the nature of the information to be furnished, the Census
Officer may direct by means of instructions in a census schedule or by separate
notice, the precise nature of the particulars required.

15 Neglect or refusal to supply particulars and false particulars

Subject to section 12 every person commits an offence who neglects or
refuses to furnish any census schedule as required by this Act or to answer any
questions lawfully put to him for the purposes of the census, or who knowingly
makes any statements or gives any answer untrue in any material particular
required by this Act, and is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

Census Act 1971

231

16 Mutilation or defacement of schedules

Every person commits an offence who, without lawful authority, mutilates
or defaces a census schedule or other census document or record containing
particulars collected under this Act or requesting any such particulars and is liable
to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

17 Divulging information

Every person commits an offence, who, whether or not he is a census
employee appointed to any duty in connection with the census, divulges or makes
use of any information obtained pursuant to this Act except as required for the
preparation of statistics from the data obtained at the census, and is liable to a fine
not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

18 Hindering census employee

Every person commits an offence who hinders or obstructs any census
employee in pursuance of his duty and is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty
units.

19 Preparation of statistics

(1) The information furnished under this Act shall be used for statistical
purposes only.
(2) Subject to this Act and with the approval of the Cabinet, the Census
Officer may have statistics prepared from the data obtained at the census and
may publish such statistics, with or without observations.
(3) Every person employed for the purpose of preparing such statistics
before entering on his duties, shall take and subscribe to the oath contained in
section 6.
(4) It shall be a principle to be followed in the publication of statistics to
arrange, wherever possible, statistical tables in such a manner as to prevent any
particulars published in the tables from being identifiable by any person (other
than by the person by whom the particulars were supplied) as particulars relating
to any particular person, unless that person has consented to their publication in
that manner, and for that purpose the Census Officer shall make such rules as he
considers necessary in the public interest.

20 [Spent]

232 Niue Laws 2006 Vall

233

CHATTELS TRANSFER ACT 1924

1924/49 – 1 January 1925

11-13 [Repealed]

Renewal of Registration

14 Registration of instruments must be

renewed within five years

Searches and Copies

15 Register book and instruments may be

searched and viewed

16 Copies may be had

17 Instruments and affidavits presumed to

have been duly executed or sworn

Effect of Non-registration

18 Unregistered instruments to be void in

certain cases

19 Unregistered instrument not to affect bona

fide purchaser for value

19A [Repealed]

AS TO INSTRUMENTS GENERALLY

20 Instrument to be attested

21 Instrument to take effect from execution

22 Registration to give priority

23 Instrument to have inventory of chattels

24 Instrument void where grantor not

owner of chattels

25 Instrument subject to defeasance, void

in certain cases

26 Saving

27 [Repealed]

38-41 [Repealed]

Entry of Satisfaction

42 Memorandum of satisfaction may be

filed

43 Effect of filing such memorandum

44 [Repealed]

45 Judge may order memorandum to be

filed

Sales by Registrar

46 Sales by Registrar

Sale of Grantor’s Interest

47 Grantor ’s interest in chattels may be sold

in execution

48 Not to affect interpleader process

IMPLIED COVENANTS

49 Covenants for title

50 Covenants implied in instruments by

way of security

51 Meaning of “abbreviated expressions”

52 Covenants to be several as well as joint

53 Covenants to bind executors

54 Covenants may be negatived or varied

234 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

TRANSFERS OF INSTRUMENTS

PENAL

55

Form of transfer of instrument

58

Attempt to defraud grantee

56

Registration of transfers

59-5

9A [Repealed]

CUSTOMARY HIRE PURCHASE AGREEMENTS

REPEALS AND SAVINGS

57

Special provisions as to customary hire

60

[Repealed]

purchase agreements

61

Regulations

57A

Customary hire purchase agreements to

62

Act binds the Government

have inventory

57B Finance corporations to be dealers SCHEDULES

1 Short title

This is the Chattels Transfer Act 1924.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“chattels” means any personal property that can be completely transferred
by delivery, and includes machinery, stock and the natural increase of
stock as hereinafter mentioned, crops and also includes book debts but
does not include –
(a) Chattel interests in real estate, title deeds, choses in action (not being
book debts), negotiable instruments; or
(b) Shares and interests in the stock, funds, or securities of any
Government or local authority; or
(c) Shares and interests in the capital or property of any company or
other corporate body; or
(d) Debentures and interest coupons issued by any Government, or
local authority, or other corporate body;
“crops” means European flax, hemp, hops, wheat, maize, barley, oats, and
grass (whether for hay or for grain), and all cereal and root crops,

Phormium tenax, fruit and all other crops grown above or below the

ground;
“executed” means signed by the grantor or his attorney, and, in the case of
an instrument by way of bailment, means signed by the grantor and
grantee or their respective attorneys;
“factory” or “workshop” means any premises on which any manual labour
is exercised by way of trade or for the purposes of gain or in or about
the making, altering, repairing, ornamenting, finishing, or adapting for
sale of any article or part of any article;
“grantee” means the party to an instrument to whom chattels in it referred
to, or any interest in it, are thereby granted or assigned, or agreed so to
be, and includes his executors, administrators, and assigns; and in the
case of a company or corporation includes the successors and assigns
of such company or corporation;
“grantor” means the party to an instrument who thereby grants or assigns,
or agrees to grant or assign, chattels referred to in it, or any interest in
it, and includes his executors, administrators, and assigns; and in the
case of a company or corporation includes the successors and assigns
of such company or corporation;

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

235
“instrument” means and includes any bill of sale, mortgage lien, or any other document that transfers or purports to transfer the property in or right to the possession of chattels, whether permanently or temporarily, whether absolutely or conditionally, and whether by way of sale, security, pledge, gift, settlement, bailment, or lease, and also the following:
(a) Inventories of chattels, with receipt to it attached; (b) Receipts for purchase money of chattels;
(c) Other assurances of chattels;
(d) Declarations of trust without transfer;
(e) Powers of attorney, authorities, or licences to take possession of
chattels as security for any debt;
(f) Any agreement, whether intended to be followed by the execution
of any other instrument or not, by which a right in equity to any
chattels, or to any charge or security on it or over it, is conferred;
“instrument” does not include the following –
(a) Securities over, or bailments or leases of, fixtures (except “trade
machinery” as hereinafter defined), when mortgaged or leased in
any mortgage or lease of any freehold or leasehold interest in any
land or buildings to which they are affixed, and whether or not
such fixtures are separately mortgaged or leased by mention thereof
in separate words, and whether or not power is given by such
mortgage or lease to sever such fixtures from the land or building
to which they are affixed without otherwise taking possession of
or dealing with such land or building;
(b) Assignments for the benefit of the creditors of the person making
the same;
(c) Transfers of or agreements to transfer instruments by way of
security;
(d) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(e) Transfers of chattels in the ordinary course of business of any trade
or calling;
(f) Debentures and interest coupons issued by any Government or local
authority;
(g) Bills of sale of chattels in any foreign parts, or at sea;
(h) Bills of lading, warehouse keepers’ certificates, warrants, or orders
for the delivery of chattels, entries in auctioneers’ books, or any
other document used in the ordinary course of business as proof of
the possession or control of chattels, or authorising or purporting
to authorise, either by endorsement or delivery, the possessor of
such document to transfer or receive the chattels thereby
represented;
(i) Debentures and interest coupons issued by any company or other
corporate body and secured upon the capital stock or chattels of
such company or other corporate body;
(j) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(k) Customary hire purchase agreements as defined in this Act;
“instrument by way of bailment” means an instrument whereby chattels
are leased or bailed;
“instrument by way of security” means an instrument given to secure the
payment of money or the performance of some obligation;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of the High Court and includes a Deputy
Registrar (if any);
236 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“registration” means the filing of an instrument with schedule or inventories, or a true copy of it, with the certificate hereinafter mentioned;
“stock” includes any sheep, cattle, horses, pigs, poultry, ostriches, and any other living animals;
“trade machinery” means the machinery used in or attached to any factory
or workshop, but does not include –
(a) The fixed motive powers, such as the water wheels, and steam and
other engines, and the steam boilers, donkey engines, and other
fixed appurtenances of the said motive powers; or
(b) The fixed power machinery (such as the shafts, wheels, drums, and
their fixed appurtenances) for transmitting the action of the motive
powers to the other machinery, fixed and loose; or
(c) The pipes for steam, gas and water.

3 Agreement giving power of distress

(1) (a) An attornment or agreement (not being a mining lease) whereby a
power of distress is given or agreed to be given by one person to
another by way of security for any present, future, or contingent
debt or advance, and whereby any rent is reserved or made payable
as a means of providing for the payment of interest on such debt or
advance, or otherwise for the purpose of such security only, shall
be deemed to be an instrument within the meaning of this Act so
far as regards any chattels seized or taken under the power of
distress.
(b) Nothing in this subsection shall prejudice the right of a landlord to
distrain for rent.
(c) Where a mortgagee of any interest in land, after entering (under
the powers contained or implied in the mortgage) into possession
of the mortgaged land, or into receipt of the rents and profits of the
land, demises the land or any part of it to the mortgagor at a fair
and reasonable rent, the instrument whereby such demise is effected
shall not be deemed to be an instrument within the meaning of this
Act.
(2) Machinery and plant used in milking, and machinery and plant used
for shearing, shall not by reason of being attached to buildings or land become
part of the land, nor shall any estate or interest therein pass by virtue of such
attachment.
REGISTRATION

4 Registration of instrument to be notice

(1) (a) Save as provided in subsection (3) all persons shall be deemed to
have notice of an instrument and of its contents when and so soon
as such instrument has been registered.
(b) If registration of such instrument is not renewed under this Act,
prior registration shall not be deemed to operate as notice after the
lapse of the period within which renewal is required by this Act.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) Registration of any instrument to which subsection (1) or (2) applies
shall not in itself constitute notice of the existence of that instrument or of its
contents to the grantee of any prior registered instrument relating to the same
chattels or to any of those chattels.

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

237

5 Mode of registration

(1) Registration of an instrument shall be effected by filing it and all
schedules endorsed on it or referred to in it, or a true copy of the instrument and
schedules and a certificate in the form numbered 1 in Schedule 1, with the Registrar
of the High Court.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) Every person commits an offence and is liable on summary conviction
to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit who wilfully or negligently signs any
certificate in the form numbered 1 in Schedule 1 or to the like effect in respect of
any instrument if the certificate is false in a material respect.

6 Where instrument made under process

Where an instrument is made by any person under or in execution of any
process of court, the certificate to be filed on registration shall state the residence
and occupation of the person against whom such process is issued.

7 Affidavits

An affidavit required by this Act may be sworn before any solicitor of the
High Court, or a Registrar, or any Justice.

8 Limitation of time for registration

(1) The period within which an instrument may be registered is 21 days
from the day on which it was executed.
(2) If there are more grantors than one, the date of execution of the
instrument shall be deemed to be the date of the execution by the grantor who
first executes the instrument.
(3) The day on which the instrument is executed shall not be included in
the period for registration; but the instrument may be registered on that day.

9 Register book and index to be kept

(1) The Registrar shall cause every instrument registered in his office to be
numbered, and shall mark on each such instrument, or on the filed copy of it, the
date of registration and the number, and shall at the time of registration enter in a
register to be kept for the purpose of his office the particulars of the instrument
registered under the form numbered 2 in Schedule 1.
(2) The Registrar shall also keep an index in which he shall enter the names
of the grantors of instruments by way of security and of the grantors and grantees
of all other instruments, and shall refer in it to the entries in the register book of
the instruments given by each such grantor.
(3) Such index shall be arranged in divisions corresponding with the letters
of the alphabet, so that all grantors and grantees whose surnames begin with the
same letter (and no others) shall be comprised in one division, but the arrangement
within each such division need not be strictly alphabetical.

10 Entry where instrument made under process

Where any instrument is made or given by any person under or in the
execution of any process of court, then the name, residence, and occupation of the
person against whom such process issued, and also the name of the grantee of it,
shall be inserted in the book to be kept as aforesaid.

11 [Repealed]

238 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

12-13 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Renewal of Registration

14 Registration of instruments must be renewed within five years

(1) The registration of an instrument shall cease to be of any effect at the
expiration of 5 years from the date of the registration or, where the registration
has been renewed under this section, at the expiration of 5 years from the date of
the renewal of the registration or of the last renewal of the registration, as the case
may be.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/70]
(3) The registration of an instrument shall be renewed by filing in the office
of the Registrar an affidavit in the form numbered 3 in Schedule 1 or to the like
effect.
(4) The Registrar shall thereupon number such affidavit as if the same were an instrument presented for registration, and renumber the instrument originally registered in the said office, or the filed copy of it, with a similar number, and mark thereon the date of renewal of registration, and shall enter particulars of the instrument in the register book in like manner as on an original registration, and shall also enter the date of renewal of registration in the column provided therefor in the register book.

Searches and Copies

15 Register book and instruments may be searched and viewed

The register books and indices hereinbefore provided for, and every
instrument registered as aforesaid, or the filed copy of it, may be searched and
viewed by all persons during the office hours of the High Court.

16 Copies may be had

Any person shall be entitled to have a copy or an extract of or from any
instrument with the schedules filed therewith, or of or from the copy of it registered
as aforesaid, and a copy of any affidavit filed under this Act; or if he makes such
copy or extract himself the Registrar shall, upon satisfying himself that such copy
or extract is correctly made, certify the same.

17 Instruments and affidavits presumed to have been duly executed or sworn (1) Every instrument registered and certificate or affidavit filed shall, if purporting to be duly executed or sworn, be prima facie presumed to have been

duly executed or sworn.
(2) The filed copy of any instrument, and of the schedules filed therewith,
or an office copy of any such filed copy, and an office copy of any affidavit or
certificate filed under this Act, and every copy or extract certified by the Registrar
under Section 16, and a certificate by the Registrar of the time when any instrument,
affidavit, or certificate was registered or filed, shall in all courts and before all
persons having by law or consent of parties authority to take evidence be received
as prima facie evidence of such instrument, schedules, affidavit, or certificate and
of the signatures of the parties to the instrument and of the attesting witnesses
thereto, and of the fact and time of the registration or filing of the instrument
affidavit, or certificate.
(3) It shall not be necessary to prove the handwriting or official position of
the person appearing as such Registrar to have certified any such copy or extract
or to have given any such certificate.

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

239

Effect of Non-registration

18 Unregistered instruments to be void in certain cases

(1) Every instrument, unless registered in the manner hereinbefore
provided, shall, upon the expiration of the time for registration, or if the time for
registration is extended by a Judge of the High Court, then upon the expiration of
such extended time, be deemed fraudulent and void as against –
(a) The Assignee in Bankruptcy of the estate of the person whose
chattels or any of them are comprised in any such instrument;
(b) The assignee or trustee acting under any assignment for the benefit
of the creditors of such person;
(c) Any sheriff, bailiff, and other person seizing the chattels or any
part thereof comprised in any such instrument, in execution of the
process of any Court authorising the seizure of the chattels of the
person by whom or concerning whose chattels such instrument was
made, and against every person on whose behalf such process was
issued –
so far as regards the property in or right to the possession of any chattels comprised
in or affected by the instrument which, at or after the time of such bankruptcy, or
of the execution by the grantor of such assignment for the benefit of his creditors,
or of the execution of such process (as the case may be), and after the expiration of
the period within which the instrument is required to be registered, are in the
possession or apparent possession of the person making or giving the instrument,
or of any person against whom the process was issued under or in the execution
of which the instrument was made or given.

19 Unregistered instrument not to affect bona fide purchaser for value

Upon the expiration of the time or extended time for registration no
unregistered instrument comprising any chattels whatsoever shall, without express
notice, be valid and effectual as against any bona fide purchaser or mortgagee for
valuable consideration, or as against any person bona fide selling or dealing with
such chattels as auctioneer or dealer or agent in the ordinary course of his business.

19A [Repealed by 2004/270]

AS TO INSTRUMENTS GENERALLY

20 Instrument to be attested

Sealing shall not be essential to the validity of any instrument; but every
execution of an instrument shall be attested by at least one witness, who shall add
to his signature his residence and occupation.

21 Instrument to take effect from execution

Every instrument shall be deemed to be made on the day on which it is
executed, and shall take effect from the time of its execution.

22 Registration to give priority

(1) Where 2 or more instruments are executed comprising in whole or in
part any of the same chattels, priority shall be given to such instrument or
instruments in the order of time of their registration respectively as regards the
title to or right to the possession of such chattels.
(2) Where a grantee under a second or subsequent instrument claims
priority by virtue of prior registration he must prove that at the time of the execution
of the instrument under which he claims he had no notice of any existing
unregistered instrument.
240 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

23 Instrument to have inventory of chattels

Every instrument shall contain, or shall have endorsed on it or annexed to
it, a schedule of the chattels comprised in and, save as is otherwise expressly
provided by this Act, shall give a good title only to the chattels described in the
said schedule, and shall be void to the extent and as against the persons mentioned
in sections 18 and 19 in respect of any chattels not so described.

24 Instrument void where grantor not owner of chattels

(1) Save as is otherwise expressly provided by this Act, an instrument shall
be void to the extent and as against the persons mentioned in section 18 and 19 in
respect of any chattels which the grantor acquires or becomes entitled to after the
time of the execution of the instrument.
(2) Where an instrument by way of security over any chattels is therein
expressed to be given as security for a loan to be expended, in whole or in part, in
the purchase of those chattels, the grantor shall be deemed to have acquired the
said chattels contemporaneously with the execution of this instrument.

25 Instrument subject to defeasance, void in certain cases

(1) If an instrument is made or given subject to any defeasance, condition
or declaration of trust not contained in the body of the instrument, such defeasance,
condition, or declaration of trust shall for the purposes of this Act be taken as part
of such instrument, and shall be written on the same paper or parchment on which
such instrument is written, otherwise such instrument shall be void to the extent
and as against the persons mentioned in section 18 so far as regards the property
in or right to the possession of any chattels comprised in or affected by such
instrument.
(2) In the case of a document securing the payment of the moneys or any
part of it payable by virtue of an instrument it shall not be necessary for the
purposes of this section to write such document on the same paper or parchment
so long as the date, names of the parties to it, and the nature of the security are set
forth in the instrument or in some schedule to it.

26 Saving

Nothing in sections 23-25 shall render an instrument void in respect of the
following chattels, that is to say –
(a) Stock, wool and crops;
(b) Fixtures, plant, or trade machinery where the same are used in,
attached to, or brought upon any place in substitution for any of
the like nature described in, or in the schedule to, such instrument;
(c) Tractors, engines, machines, vehicles, implements and farming plant
of every description described in such instrument and used upon
or in connection with any land or premises specified in the
instrument.

27 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Instruments Comprising Stock

28 How stock to be described

In any instrument they shall be described or referred to therein or in the
schedule by some brand or brands, earmark or earmarks, or other mark or marks
upon them, or shall be so described or referred to by sex, age, name, colour, or
other mode of description as to be reasonably capable of identification, otherwise

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

241
the instrument shall be void to the extent and as against the persons mentioned in section 18, so far a regards such or so much of such stock as are not so described or referred to or are not reasonably capable of identification; and the land or premises on which such stock are or are intended to be depastured or kept shall be described or mentioned in such instrument or schedule.

29 Stock to include increase of stock

An instrument comprising stock shall, unless the contrary be expressed
therein, be deemed to include not only the stock comprised therein as provided
by section 28, but also the natural increase of such stock, and all stock of the class
or classes described in the instrument, the property of the grantor, branded,
earmarked, or marked as specified in the instrument, or which the grantor has
covenanted or agreed by such instrument to so brand, earmark, or mark, and
which after the execution of such instrument are depasturing or are at, in, or upon
any lands or premises mentioned in such instrument or in the schedule to it, on
any land and premises used and worked as part of the first-mentioned land and
premises, whether or not such stock be removed therefrom. The grantee shall
have the same legal property and right in all stock which by force of this section
are deemed to be included in the instrument as he has in the stock described in
the instrument or in the schedule to it.

30 Special provisions as to poultry

Where the stock comprised in an instrument is poultry or ostriches, or other
stock which cannot be properly the subject of distinctive marking –
(a) Section 28 shall not apply in respect of such stock;
(b) Section 29 shall apply, but modified by omitting therefrom, after
the words “be deemed to include”, the words “not only the stock
comprised therein as provided by the last preceding section, but
also”; and by further omitting after the words “the property of the
grantor”, the words “branded, earmarked, or marked as specified
in the instrument, or which the grantor has covenanted or agreed
by such instrument to so brand, earmark, or mark, and”.

31 [Repealed]

32 Book debts

(1) For the purposes of this Act book debts shall be deemed to be chattels,
and shall be deemed to be situate in the place where the grantor of the instrument
comprising them longest resided or carried on business during the period of 6
months next before the execution of the instrument.
(2) For the purposes of any instrument comprising book debts each debt
shall be deemed to be a separate chattel, and shall be described by setting forth
the amount of the debt and the name of the debtor or firm of debtors so far as is
reasonably necessary to show by whom the debt is owing.
(3) For the purposes of this Act “book debts” means debts owing to any
person in the course of his trade or business, but does not include any debt secured
or charged on land, or any debt owing to any person for or in respect of any milk,
cream, or butterfat supplied by him to any butter factory, cheese factory, condensed
milk factory, or milk powder factory.
242 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
AS TO INSTRUMENTS BY WAY OF SECURITY

33 Form of instrument by way of security

(1) Every instrument by way of security may be in the form numbered 4 in
Schedule 1 or to the like effect, with such variations or modifications and additions
to it as are expressed in the instrument.
(2) An instrument by way of security securing an account current continues
in full force and effect notwithstanding that the grantor may be in credit on such
account.

34 Where successive securities are given over same chattels

Where an instrument by way of security is executed after the execution of
a prior instrument which has never been registered, and comprises all or any of
the chattels comprised in such prior instrument, then if such subsequent instrument
is given as a security for the same debt as is secured by the prior instrument, or for
any part of such debt, it shall, to the extent to which it is a security for the same
debt or part thereof, and so far as respects the chattels comprised in the prior
instrument, be void to the extent and as against the persons mentioned in section
18 unless it is proved to the court having cognisance of the case that the subsequent
instrument was bona fide given for the purpose of correcting some material error
in the prior instrument, and not for the purpose of evading this Act.

Securities Over Crops

35 Security may be given over crops

An instrument by way of security may be granted over the crops described
or referred to in it or in the schedule in to it then actually sown or growing, or to
be sown or grown in or upon the lands mentioned in the instrument, and shall
entitle the grantee of it to the whole of the crops in it mentioned, not only while
growing, but afterwards when cut or separated from the soil, and whether stacked
or stored on the land where the same were grown on or on any other land or
premises.

36 Crops that cannot be harvested within 12 months

No such instrument shall avail to give security over any crops (other than

Phormium tenax) that cannot in the ordinary course of husbandry be harvested

and taken off such land within one year from the date of the execution of the
instrument.

37 Saving of rights of landlord and mortgagee

(1) No such instrument shall prejudicially affect the rights of any landlord
or mortgagee of any land whereon the said crops are growing, unless and so far as
the landlord or mortgagee has consented in writing to such instrument.
(2) No such instrument being duly registered shall be extinguished or
prejudicially affected by any subsequent sale, lease, mortgage, or other
encumbrance of or upon the land described or referred to in the instrument or in
any schedule thereto.

38-41 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

243

Entry of Satisfaction

42 Memorandum of satisfaction may be filed

(1) In the case of an instrument by way of security, upon the production to
the Registrar of a memorandum of satisfaction in the form numbered 5 in Schedule
1 or to the like effect, signed by the grantee of it or his attorney, discharging the
chattels comprised in such instrument or any specified part of it from the moneys
secured thereby or any specified part thereof, or from the performance of the
obligation thereby secured or any specified part of it, and on production of such
instrument the Registrar shall file such memorandum and make an entry thereof
in the register book on the page where the instrument is registered.
(2) (a)The execution of such memorandum shall be attested by at least one
witness, who shall add to his signature his residence and occupation,
and shall be verified by the affidavit of that witness.
(b) It is not necessary for the execution to be verified by affidavit if –
(i) the witness is the Registrar, a notary public, a Justice of the
Peace, Postmaster, or a solicitor of the High Court, resident in
Niue; or
(ii) the grantee is a corporation and the memorandum is executed
by the corporation affixing its common seal or its official seal
for use in Niue.
(3) The Registrar may dispense with the production of the instrument on
proof by affidavit to his satisfaction that the instrument has been destroyed, cannot
be found, or cannot be produced.

43 Effect of filing such memorandum

From and after the filing of any such memorandum the debt or charge
created by the instrument shall be vacated to the extent specified in the
memorandum, and the interest of the grantee in the chattels expressed to be
discharged shall vest in the person for the time being entitled to the equity of
redemption but so far only as such interest is expressed by the memorandum to
be determined, and subject to any lien or equity affecting the chattels.

44 [Repealed by 2004/270]

45 Judge may order memorandum to be filed

A Judge of the High Court may, upon application made to him for that
purpose, order a memorandum of satisfaction to be filed in respect of any
instrument by way of security if it appears to him that the debt (if any) for which
such instrument was given as security has been satisfied or discharged, or that
the obligation for securing the performance of which the instrument was given
has been performed; and thereupon such order may be filed by the Registrar and
entered in his book in like manner as if the same were a memorandum within the
meaning of section 42.
244 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

46 Sales by Registrar

(1) Where a person is entitled to exercise the power of sale contained or
implied in an instrument, that person may apply in writing to the Registrar for
the property to be sold.
(2) As soon as practicable after receiving an application under this section
the Registrar shall –
(a) Fix a convenient time (being not more than 3 months and not less
than one month from the date of the application) and a convenient
place for the conduct of the sale; and
(b) Give written notice to any person (including the debtor) whose
name and address has been supplied by the applicant, of the time
and place at which the sale is to be conducted, and of the redemption
price of the property to be sold; and
(c) Give such public notice of the sale as he considers sufficient; and
(d) Approve proper conditions of sale and do all other things necessary
for the proper conduct of the sale.
(3) (a) At any time before the sale the debtor may pay to the applicant
either the redemption price, or the amount due and owing under
the instrument, together with the expenses already incurred by the
applicant in connection with the intended sale, and any money
expended on or about the property subsequent to the time when
the redemption price in the application for sale was fixed, and on
such payment the applicant shall do the acts required by clause 10
of Schedule 4.
(b) Where the sum so paid is less than the amount owing under the
instrument the balance may be recovered from the debtor under
the covenant to repay expressed or implied in the instrument.
(4) The applicant may be a bidder at any such sale, and become the
purchaser of the property or any part of it.
(5) In the event of the applicant being the purchaser, the Registrar shall
execute a memorandum of conveyance of the property purchased containing a
recital that the sale has been made under this section.
(6) In the memorandum the consideration to be stated shall be not less
than the redemption price.
(7) Upon the execution of the memorandum by the Registrar, the property
shall vest in the applicant in the same manner as if it had been conveyed to a third
party purchaser at the sale.
(8) A memorandum of transfer executed by the Registrar upon a sale under
this section shall be conclusive proof that the provisions of this Act relating to the
sale have been complied with.
(9) If any surplus money arising from the sale of the property cannot be
paid to the debtor by reason of his not being found after reasonable inquiry the
money shall vest in the Government.
(10) In respect of every application under this section there shall be paid to
the Registrar by the applicant, in addition to the reasonable expenses of the sale a
fee of $100 which shall accompany the application.

47 Grantor’s interest in chattels may be sold in execution

(1) Where legal process issues against the chattels of a judgment debtor
for the execution of a judgment of any Court, and the said chattels, or any of
them, are comprised in any instrument by way of security, the officer charged
with the execution of the process may, in lieu of seizing and selling the chattels so
comprised, sell the right, title and interest of the judgment debtor in the same.

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

245
(2) The grantee of the instrument, on receiving notice of the purchase of that right, title, and interest, may take possession of the chattels comprised in the instrument.
(3) A grantee so taking possession shall be deemed to hold the chattels in trust for the purchaser of the said right, title, and interest, subject to payment of all moneys due under the instrument.
(4) If the chattels are afterwards sold under the power of sale expressed or implied in the instrument, and any surplus remains out of the proceeds of the sale after payment of all moneys due under the instrument, the grantee shall on demand pay over that surplus to the purchaser of the said right, title and interest.
(5) If the grantee makes default, the purchaser may bring an action against him to recover the surplus, as money received to the use of the purchaser.

48 Not to affect interpleader process

Nothing in section 47 shall be deemed to affect the right of an execution
creditor to test the validity of any instrument by interpleader process.

49 Covenants for title

IMPLIED COVENANTS
There shall be implied in every instrument the covenants for title on the part of the grantor set forth in Schedule 3, and such implied covenants shall have the same effect as if the same were respectively set out at length in the instrument.

50 Covenants implied in instruments by way of security

There shall be implied in every instrument by way of security the covenants,
provisos, agreements, and powers set out in Schedule 4 or such of them as are
applicable; and such implied covenants, provisos, agreements, and powers shall,
subject to any modification of the same expressed in the instrument, have the
same effect as if the same were respectively set out in it at length.

51 Meaning of “abbreviated expressions”

Such of the expressions defined in section 2 or in Schedule 5 as are used in
any instrument, or in any of the covenants, provisos, agreements, or powers implied
therein by this Act, shall, unless the contrary is expressed in such instrument, or
unless manifestly inconsistent with the context, have the meanings given to the
same in section 2 or Schedule 5 and such meanings shall be implied in such
instrument as fully and effectually as if the same were set out in it.

52 Covenants to be several as well as joint

Where there are 2 or more grantors or 2 or more grantees of any instrument,
then any covenants, conditions, provisos, agreements, and powers expressed in
such instrument, or implied by this Act, and imposing an obligation on such
grantors or grantees, or enuring fore the benefit of such grantors or grantees, shall,
except in so far as a contrary intention appears, be deemed to impose such
obligation, or confer such benefit as the case may be, severally as well as jointly.

53 Covenants to bind executors

Except in so far as a contrary intention appear, all covenants, conditions,
provisos, agreements, and powers expressed in any instrument, or implied therein
by this Act, shall bind the executors, administrators, and assigns of the person, or
the successors and assigns of a company or corporation, upon whom such
covenants, conditions, provisos, agreements, and powers impose an obligation
246 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
and shall operate for the benefit of the executors, administrators, and assigns of the person, or the successors and assigns of the company or corporation, for whose benefit the same enure.

54 Covenants may be negatived or varied

All or any of the covenants, provisos, conditions, agreements, or powers
set forth in Schedules 3, 4 and 5 may be negatived, modified, or altered, or others
may be added to them, by express words in the instrument.
TRANSFERS OF INSTRUMENTS

55 Form of transfer of instrument

Every instrument may be transferred by a document in the form in Schedule
6 or to the like effect, and every transferee, his executors, administrators, and
assigns, shall, in respect of the instrument transferred, have the same rights, powers
and remedies, and be subject to the same obligations, as the transferor.

56 Registration of transfers

Transfers of instruments by way of security may be registered at any time
after the execution of it in like manner as instruments are registered; and, in case
2 or more transfers of any one such instrument are executed, a registered transfer
shall have priority over an unregistered transfer; and, in case 2 or more transfers
or any one such instrument are registered, priority shall be given to such transfers
in the order of their time of registration.
CUSTOMARY HIRE PURCHASE AGREEMENTS

57 Special provisions as to customary hire purchase agreements

(1) A customary hire purchase agreement is a deed or agreement in writing
made between the owner of or a dealer in certain chattels and a conditional
purchaser of those chattels where –
(a) The owner of or dealer in the chattels is either the manufacturer
thereof or a person who is engaged in the trade or business of selling
or disposing of chattels of such nature or description;
(b) The deed or agreement provides expressly or impliedly for delivery
of possession to the conditional purchaser, but that the property in
the chattels shall not pass to the conditional purchaser, or shall only
conditionally so pass, until the completion of the payments to be
made by him;
(c) The chattels the subject of the deed or agreement are described in
Schedule 7 at the time when the agreement is made.
(2) A customary hire purchase agreement may be either an actual contract
for sale and purchase or a contract of bailment under which the purchaser has an
option of purchase of the chattels defined in the agreement.
(3) A customary hire purchase agreement and any assignment of a
customary hire purchase agreement and of the chattels the subject of the agreement,
whether absolute or by way of mortgage is valid and effectual for all purposes
without registration.
(4) [Repealed]
(5) The purchaser or bailee of chattels the subject of a customary hire
purchase agreement shall not have any right to sell, deal with, or dispose of such
chattels otherwise than as may be specially provided in the agreement; and no
sale, dealing, or other disposition purported to be made by such purchaser or
bailee shall be effectual to confer title upon any person as against the vendor or
bailor named in the customary hire purchase agreement, or against the assigns of
such vendor or bailor.

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

247
(6) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(7) (a) Any chattels which now or hereafter are the subject of a customary
hire purchase agreement shall, notwithstanding any rule of law to
the contrary, remain and be deemed to have remained in all respects
chattels although the same may have been fixed or attached to any
land or building, and shall be removable by the vendor or bailor if
and when he shall become entitled to possession of the same under
the provisions of such customary hire purchase agreement;
(b) Such vendor or bailor shall not be entitled to remove any such
chattels fixed to such land or building without first giving to the
owner or other person for the time being in possession of the said
land one month’s previous notice in writing of his intention to so
remove them.

57A Customary hire purchase agreements to have inventory

Section 23 shall apply to customary hire purchase agreements as defined
in section 57 to the same extent as if such agreements were instruments.

57B Finance corporations to be dealers

(1) In this section –
“customary chattels” means chattels described in Schedule 7.
“finance corporation” means a corporate body engaged in financing
transactions in relation to purchasers of customary chattels on hire
purchase terms or conditional sale.
(2) A finance corporation shall be deemed for all the purposes of section
57 to be a dealer engaged in the trade or business of selling or disposing of
customary chattels, and a deed or agreement of hire purchase between a finance
corporation and a conditional purchaser of a customary chattel in relation to such
customary chattel shall for those purposes be deemed to be a customary hire
purchase agreement.
(3) Customary chattels the property of a wholesale dealer in the possession
of a retail dealer for the purposes of sale, hire, or demonstration shall not be deemed
to be in the order and disposition of the retail dealer with the consent of the true
owner thereof within the meaning of any law relating to bankruptcy or insolvency.
(4) An agreement in relation to customary chattels, made between the
manufacturer or a wholesaler dealer in such chattels or a finance corporation and
a retailer dealer in such chattels, by which possession of the chattels is given to
such dealer, shall not be deemed to be a customary hire purchase agreement.
(5) (a) Section 57(5) shall be read subject to section 3 of the Mercantile
Law Act 1908.
(b) For the purposes of section 3 of the Mercantile Law Act, a person
entitled to the benefit of a customary hire purchase agreement as
assignee or mortgagee shall be deemed to be the true owner of any
customary chattels the subject of such hire purchase agreement.

58 Attempt to defraud grantee

PENAL
Every grantor of an instrument by way of security who, by sale or delivery without the consent of the grantee of any chattels comprised in or affected by such instrument, or by any other means, defrauds or attempts to defraud the grantee of the same or any part thereof, and thus or by any other means directly or indirectly defeats, in validates, or impairs the grantee’s security over the same,
248 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
and every person who wilfully aids and abets any person in defrauding or attempting to defraud the grantee by defeating, invalidating, or impairing such instrument or in attempting to do so, is liable to 2 years’ imprisonment and to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

59-59A [Repealed by 2004/270]

REPEALS AND SAVINGS

60 [Repealed by 2004/270]

61 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations for the purposes of this Act and may
prescribe the fees to be payable under this Act.

62 Act binds the Government

This Act binds the Government in respect of all instruments to which the
Government is a party.

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Section 2 (3)

(1) CERTIFICATE ON REGISTRATION OF INSTRUMENT

I, [Full name], of [Place of residence or business], in Niue, [Occupation], hereby certify:

1. That I was present and saw (this instrument*) or (the instrument of which this

is a true copy*) or (the instrument of which the paper writing hereto annexed and marked

“A” is a true copy*) executed by [Full name, place of residence, and occupation of grantor]

(and the other signatures to it†) (by his attorney [Full name of attorney]*) or (by their

respective attorneys [Full names of attorneys]* on the day of

20 at .

2. That my signature in my proper handwriting appears on the said instrument

as that of the witness who attested its execution by the said [Full name of grantor] (and

other signatories to it†).

3. That I am aware that I am guilty of an offence if this certificate is false in a

material respect and I give it negligently or knowing it to be false.

Signed at this day of 20 .

*Delete if inapplicable.

†Delete if there are no other signatories. If the instrument is by way of bailment it must be signed

by both grantor and grantee or their respective attorneys and this certificate must relate to the

execution of the instrument by both parties.

NOTE: Where the grantor is a company or corporation the registered office of the grantor or its principal place of business in Niue should be stated in this form instead of the place of residence of the grantor and it shall not be necessary to state the occupation of such a grantor.

Section 9

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

(2) REGISTER BOOK

249

No.

By Whom Given for Against Whom

Process Issued

To Whom Given

Nature and Date of Instrument

Date and Time of Registration

Date of

Renewal

Satisfaction

Entered

No.

Name

Resi­

dence

Occu­

pation

Name

Resi­

dence

Occu­

pation

Nature and Date of Instrument

Date and Time of Registration

Date of

Renewal

Satisfaction

Entered

N.B. in the case of an instrument by way of security it shall not be imperative to state the residence and occupation of the grantee.

Section 14

(3) AFFIDAVIT ON RENEWAL OF REGISTRATION OF INSTRUMENT

In the High Court of Niue In the matter of the Chattels

District Transfer Act 1924

I [Full name of deponent], of [Place of residence or business], in Niue [Occupation], make oath and say as follows”

1. I am the grantee [or grantor, in the case of an instrument by way of bailment) of the instrument registered under the above Act as No. , and made between [State names of parties to instrument, their residences and occupations, as appearing therein; also names of the parties to the instrument, their residences and occupations at the time of the making of the affidavit]. [If the affidavit is made by an agent, clerk, or servant of the grantee or grantor, state such

fact, and also state briefly how deponent has become acquainted with the facts deposed to.]

2. The said instrument was registered on the day of 20.

3. The registration of the said instrument was last renewed on the day of

29.

[This paragraph is inapplicable where registration of the instrument is being renewed for

the first time.]

4. The said instrument is still subsisting, and in full force and effect.

C.D.

Sworn at , this day of 20 , before me –

G.H., Solicitor [or Registrar of the High Court, or Justice].

Section 33

(4) INSTRUMENT BY WAY OF SECURITY

A.B., of [State residence and occupation], being owner of the chattels mentioned in the schedule hereto [where a schedule is necessary], on consideration of the sum of $

this day lent and advanced to him by C.D., of [State residence and occupation], [Or, if consideration not an advance of money, state any other consideration for which mortgage given], does hereby assign and transfer the same to the said E.F. by way of mortgage, to secure the payment of the said sum of $ , on the day of 20 , with interest thereon in the meantime, and so long as the same or any part thereof remains unpaid, at the rate of $ percent per annum, by payments on the day of the months of

and in each year.

[Implied covenants, powers, and provisions may be varied or negatived.]

In witness whereof A.B. has hereunto subscribed his name, this day of

20 .

250 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

[Schedule]

Signed by the above-named A.B. in the presence of – E.F.,

[Residence and occupation]

Section 42

(5) MEMORANDUM OF SATISFACTION

A.B.

I, C.D., hereby consent to a memorandum of satisfaction being written upon the instrument

[or registered copy of the instrument] given for securing the sum of

$ , bearing date the day of 20 , and made

between and , and registered on the

day of 20 , the moneys for which such instrument was given as a security

having been satisfied.

Dated this day of 20 .

Witness: E.F.

[Residence and occupation]

SCHEDULE 2

Section 5

[Repealed 1973/2.52 (NZ)]

C.D., Grantee [or Assignee].

SCHEDULE 3

Section 49

COVENANTS IMPLIED IN ALL INSTRUMENTS

That the grantor has good right and full power to assign to the grantee the chattels purporting to be hereby assigned, and that free and clear from encumbrances other than such as are herein mentioned.

That the grantor will, at the cost of the grantee [or, if the instrument is by way of security, at the cost, until sale, of the grantor, and thereafter of the person requiring the same], do and execute all such acts, deeds, matters and things for the better assigning the chattels hereby assigned, or intended so to be, as by the grantee [ or other person before mentioned] may from time to time be reasonably required.

SCHEDULE 4

Section 50

COVENANTS IMPLIED IN INSTRUMENTS BY WAY OF SECURITY

1. That the grantor will pay to the grantee the principal money and interest hereby secured, after the rate and at the times herein mentioned, without any deduction whatever.

2. That the grantor will also pay interest on any further advances that may be secured by this instrument, computed from the time of making the same respectively, at the rate and on the dates mentioned for the payment of interest in this instrument.

3. That the grantor will not, at any time while any moneys remain owing on this security, do or allow any act or deed whereby the chattels hereby assigned shall or may become prejudicially affected, and will at all times, while any moneys remain owing on this security, duly pay all rents from time to time coming due in respect of any lands or premises on which any of the chattels hereby assigned are for the time being situated.

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

251

4. That the grantor will at all times, while, any moneys remain owing on this security, keep and maintain all and singular the chattels hereby assigned in the lie good order and condition in which they are at the date hereof; and, if any of the same are damaged or destroyed, or cease to exist, will repair such damage, or replace the chattels so destroyed or ceasing to exist, with other chattels of a like nature; and further will, if required so to do by the grantee, execute any instrument that may be necessary to give to the grantee security over chattels replacing the chattels which have been destroyed or have ceased to exist.

PROVISOS AND AGREEMENTS IMPLIED IN INSTRUMENTS BY WAY OF SECURITY

5. Provided always, and it is hereby declared and agreed, that until the grantor

makes default in the payment of any of the moneys hereby secured, or in the observance

or performance of any covenant, condition or agreement herein expressed or implied,

and on his part to be observed and performed, or until the grantor becomes bankrupt, or

until a judgment of any Court against the grantor has remained unsatisfied for 10 days,

the grantor may retain possession and use of the chattels hereby assigned.

6. Provided further that the giving by the grantor to the grantee of any bill of

exchange or promissory note for the whole or any part of the money hereby secured shall

not, until such bill or note is honoured or met, be considered as payment of or on account

of the moneys secured by this instrument, or in any way affect or alter the rights or powers

of the grantee by virtue of this instrument; and no promissory note or bill of exchange

which before, at, or at any time after the execution of this instrument may be given by the

grantor to the grantee for the whole or any portion of the moneys hereby secured, or the

remedy thereon of the grantee o of the holder of it, shall merge in the covenants herein

expressed or implied.

POWERS IMPLIED IN INSTRUMENTS BY WAY OF SECURITY

7. Provided always and it is hereby declared and agreed, that if default is made

by the grantor in payment of any of the principal or interest moneys hereby covenanted

to be paid on the day on which the same ought to be paid under the terms hereof, or in

the observance or performance of any of the covenants, conditions, or agreements herein

expressed or implied, and on the grantor ’s part to be observed and performed, or if the

grantor becomes bankrupt, or if at any time a judgment of any Court against the grantor

remains unsatisfied for ten days, then and in such case the grantee, either personally or

by his agent or servants, may immediately thereupon or at any time thereafter, without

any further consent by the grantor, and without giving to the grantor any notice, or waiting

any time, and notwithstanding any subsequent acceptance of any payment of any money

due on this security, enter upon any lands or premises whereon the chattels for the time

being subject to this security may be, and take possession thereof, and sell and dispose of

the same or any part thereof by private sale or public auction, separately or together, in

such lots and generally in such manner in every respect as the grantee deems expedient,

with power to allow time for payment of purchase money, or to buy in the said chattels or

any part of it at such auction, and to rescind or vary the terms of any contract or sale, and

to resell without being answerable for any loss or expense occasioned thereby, and to

execute all such assurances and do all such things for giving effect to any such sale as

may be necessary or proper; and the receipt of the grantee or his agent shall be a sufficient

discharge to any purchaser at such sale for any of the purchase money; and upon any sale

purporting to be made in exercise of the powers herein expressed or implied no purchaser

shall be bound to inquire as to the propriety or regularity of any such sale, or be affected

by notice express or constructive that any such sale is improper or irregular.

And it is hereby declared and agreed that the grantee shall stand possessed of the

proceeds of any such sale upon trust, after paying thereout the costs, charges and expenses

of and incidental to such taking possession, sale, and the preparation and registration of

this instrument, to apply the same in reduction of the moneys then owing on the security

of this instrument, including all moneys herein covenanted to be paid, notwithstanding

that the same may not then have become due, or that any promissory notes or bills of

exchange may then be current for the same, and to pay the balance of the grantor.

252 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

POWERS, COVENANTS AND PROVISIONS TO BE IMPLIED IN INSTRUMENTS BY WAY OF SECURITY OVER

STOCK

8. That, during the continuance of this security, the grantee, his agents or servants,

may from time to time, and at reasonable times for that purpose, enter into and upon the

said lands or premises, or any other lands or premises whereon the stock for the time

being subject to his security are depasturing, for the purpose of viewing the state and

condition of the same; and that the grantor will, upon receiving 7 days’ previous notice in

writing delivered to him personally or addressed to him through the ordinary course of

post or otherwise at his last known place of abode in Niue, give and afford to the grantee,

his agents or servants, all reasonable assistance to enable the grantee, his agents or servants,

to view the same accordingly.

9. That there are now depasturing upon the said lands and premises all the

stock herein respectively mentioned as depasturing thereon. And that the grantor will

not, during the continuance of this security, without first obtaining the grantee’s consent

in writing, further encumber the stock for the time being subject to this security, or change

the general quality, character, or description of the same, or remove the same or any part

thereof from the said lands or premises, or sell the same or any part thereof except in the

ordinary course of business, but no sale shall be made so as to reduce the number of the

stock stated in this security.

And that the grantor will, during the continuance of this security, at the usual and

convenient season for so doing, well and properly brand, earmark, and mark, with the

brand, earmark, and mark herein specified, all stock for the time being subject to this

security, so that all such stock shall bear and continue to bear the brand, earmarks, and

marks herein specified.

And will not without the leave in writing of the grantee brand, earmark, or mark,

or permit to be branded, earmarked or marked any stock for the time being subject to this

security with any brands, earmarks, or marks other than the brands, earmarks, and marks

herein specified.

And will at all times during the continuance of this security take, use, and adopt

all due and proper means for keeping and maintaining all stock now depasturing or that

may during the continuance of this security be brought upon the said lands or premises

or any part thereof, free from disease, and in clean and healthy condition: And will at all

times during the continuance of this security pay and defray all expenses in and about

the good and proper conduct and management of the said lands, stock, and premises,

and employ and maintain on the said lands, or premises efficient and proper assistance

to assist in the said conduct and management: And will every year, on demand by the

grantee, render and deliver to him a return or account in writing setting forth the number,

ages, and sexes of the stock for the time being subject to this security and the places

where the same are depasturing or kept.

10. That all stock belonging to the grantor, branded, earmarked, or marked as

aforesaid, or covenanted so to be, of which possession has been taken, under the power

in that behalf herein contained, shall be subject to the same powers, provisions,

declarations, and agreements as are herein expressed or implied of and concerning the

stock and increase of stock herein expressed to be assigned, and may be dealt with in the

same manner in all respects as if the stock of which possession is taken as aforesaid had

formed part of the stock hereby assigned: And that the grantor will, at his own cost and

charges, do and execute all such deeds, matters, and things as may be necessary, or as the

grantee may think proper, for the further, better, and more perfectly assigning and assuring

to the grantee the stock and increase of stock, and all and singular other the premises

hereby assigned or intended so to be, or the stock for the time being on the said lands or

premises, and any stock, branded, earmarked or marked as aforesaid, or covenanted so

to be, of which possession has been taken as aforesaid, so that the same may be held by

the grantee upon and for the same ends, intents, and purposes and with, under, and

subject to the same powers, provisos, agreements, and declarations, as are herein expressed

or implied of and concerning the stock and premises being expressed to be assigned: And

shall and will from time to time, and at all times during the continuance of this security,

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

253

pay all and singular the licence fees, head moneys, and other outgoings and payments and perform and observe all rules, regulations, and conditions which by the owner for the time being of the said stock or premises respectively now are or shall become at any time hereafter due, payable, observable or performable respectively: And that in case the grantor fails or neglects to pay such licence fees, head moneys, and other outgoings and payments as aforesaid, or any of them, or any part thereof, the grantee may make such payments respectively: And that in case the grantor fails or neglects to pay such licence fees, head moneys, and other outgoings and payments as aforesaid, or any of them, or any part thereof, the grantee may make such payments respectively: And that the grantor shall and will from time to time and at all times hereafter, on demand, pay or cause to be paid to the grantee all sums of money paid or advanced by the grantee in or towards such payment as aforesaid, with interest for the same time after the rate of $7 percent per annum from the time or respective times when the same were advanced or paid: And that in the meantime, and until such sums of money have been repaid with interest as aforesaid, the stock for the time being subject to this security shall stand charged and chargeable with the payment of the same in like manner as if the same had been principal moneys secured by this instrument. That in the case the grantee exercises any power of entry or taking possession vested in him hereunder, then he, or any person or persons appointed by him for the purpose, may continue in possession of the said stock and of the lands or premises whereon the same are depasturing or kept until the sale thereof, and manage, conduct, and carry on the said lands and stock, and employ servants and assistants, and provide all necessary stores in that behalf in all respects as the grantor could do if such power had not been exercised; and the grantee for any such purpose shall be entitled without any interference by the grantor to use all branding, earmarking, marking, and other implements and plant on or used in connection with the said lands or premises; and, further, that the costs, charges and expenses of so doing, from the time of such entry and taking possession until the sale and delivery of the said stock and premises to any purchaser thereof, shall together with interest thereon after the rate aforesaid, until payment, be a charge upon the stock for the time being subject to this security.

POWER TO BE IMPLIED IN INSTRUMENTS BY WAY OF SECURITY OVER CROPS

11 If the grantor does not pay to the grantee the moneys hereby secured, with

interest and commission thereof as herein mentioned, at the time herein mentioned for

payment of the same, the crops hereby assigned shall be gathered, carried away, and

made marketable either by the grantor or by the grantee at the option of the grantee, but

in either case at the expense of the grantor, and shall (if gathered by the grantor) be

delivered by the grantor to the grantee or his order at the place of delivery mentioned [or,

if no such place is mentioned in the instrument, at such place as the grantee directs]; and

the grantee may either sell the same in Niue in one or more lots, by public auction or

private contract, or partly in the one way and partly in the other, and upon such terms

and conditions as to credit and otherwise as he thinks fit, or may cause the same to be

shipped or exported to any place or places out of Niue, to be sold by his agents in the

manner and on the terms aforesaid, without being responsible for any loss or deficiency

occasioned either by the shipment of the said crop or by any sale or sales thereof, whether

in Niue or elsewhere, or by the act, neglect, or default of any agent, broker, or other

person; and may from the proceeds pay himself the moneys hereby secured, and any rent

payable to any landlord, and any moneys payable to any mortgagee or other person that

he may be compelled to pay in order to protect his security over the said crops, and all

costs, mercantile and other charges, and expenses incurred in and about the harvesting,

sale, shipment, and carrying away of such crops, and the storage and freight thereof, or

on any other account connected with the realisation thereof, and shall pay over the balance,

if any, to the grantor.

12 [Repealed by 2004/270]


254 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

SCHEDULE 5

Section 51

MEANING OF ABBREVIATED EXPRESSIONS

1. The words “upon demand” mean upon demand being made by notice in writing signed by the person entitled to make the demand, or any agent or clerk or servant of such person, served upon the person upon whom the demand is to be made, either personally or by posting the same in a duly registered letter addressed to him at his usual or last known place of abode in Niue.

2. The words “further advances” mean such further sum or sums of money as may be advanced or paid by the grantee to the grantor after the execution of this instrument, and include also such sums as may become owing by the grantor to the grantee during the continuance of this security for goods supplied, for bills and notes discounted and paid, and for other loans, credits, and advances that may during the continuance of this security be made by the grantee to or for the accommodation or at the request of the grantor.

3. The words “will, upon demand pay the balance due upon the account current between them” mean that the grantor will, on demand, pay to the grantee the balance on the account current of the grantor with the grantee for the time being owing for and on account of the moneys advanced on the execution hereof, or intended to be hereby secured, and for further advances as defined by the Chattels Transfer Act 1924, and for interest, commission and other lawful charges from the day of such demand being made till the actual payment thereof, at the rate mentioned in this instrument without any deduction; and it is hereby declared and agreed that the said account current shall be made up with half-yearly rests on the half-yearly days mentioned for that purpose in this instrument, in each year [or, if no such days are mentioned in the instrument, then on 31 March and 30

September in each year], until the final balance of account is fully paid; and that this instrument shall be a continuing security for all moneys for the time being owing by the grantor to the grantee, notwithstanding that the current account between them may have at any time theretofore been in credit by payments, settlement of account, or otherwise; and also that upon every such half-yearly day interest shall be considered as converted into principal, and the balance shall be chargeable with interest as aforesaid as upon further advances, and also that in making up such account interest at the rate specified in this instrument shall be calculated on the daily debtor balances; and also that, upon any such demand as aforesaid, all bills of exchange or promissory notes given by the grantor to the grantee and then current may, at the option of the grantee, be considered as matured or become due, subject to a rebate of interest upon the amount thereof for the time during which the same have to run, to be calculated at the rate at which interest is payable under this instrument, and that the amount of such bills or promissory notes, subject to such rebate, may be charged to the grantor in such account at the time of making such demand.

4. The words “will insure” mean that the party liable to insure will insure and at all times while this instrument remains in force will keep insured against loss or damage by fire all chattels comprised herein of a nature of kind capable of being insured against loss or damage by fire, such insurance to be effected in the name of the other party to this instrument and in some public insurance office to be approved of by him, and to be for the full amount herein specified [or, if no amount is specified, then for the full insurable value of the said chattels]; and will, at the request of the other party, hand over to and deposit with him the policy of every such insurance, and produce and deliver to him the receipt or receipts for the annual or other premiums payable on account thereof; and also that all moneys received under any such insurance shall, in the event of loss or damage by fire, be laid out and expended, so far as the same extend, in making good such loss or damage [or, if the instrument is given by way of security, in discharging the moneys hereby secured, if such other party so elects]: Provided that, if default be made in the observance or performance of this covenant, such other party may, without prejudice to and concurrently with the powers granted him by this instrument or otherwise by law, insure such chattels, and may forthwith recover the costs and charges of such insurance from the party liable to insure in like manner as if the same had been advanced by way of loan on the security of this instrument.

Chattels Transfer Act 1924

255

5. The words “will brand, earmark, and mark” mean that the party liable to brand, earmark, and mark will keep all the stock subject to this security at all times while the instrument remains in force distinctly branded, earmarked, and marked with the brands, earmarks, and marks specified in this instrument, failing which it shall be lawful for, but not imperative on, the other party hereto to enter upon any lands or premises where any stock subject to this security are and to take possession of the name, and brand, earmark, and mark the same with the brands, earmarks, and marks specified in this instrument, with the right to use all branding, earmarking, marking and other implements and plant requisite therefor, and all costs, charges, and expenses occasioned to him by so doing shall be recoverable from the party liable to brand, earmark, and mark as if the same had been advanced by way of loan as a further advance on the security of this instrument.

SCHEDULE 6

Section 55

TRANSFER OF INSTRUMENT

I, C.D. of [State residence and occupation of transferor], the grantee [or grantor, in case of an instrument by way of bailment] of the instrument registered in the office of the High Court at as no. under the Chattels Transfer Act 1924, do, in consideration of [State consideration], hereby transfer to X. Y., of [State residence and occupation of transferee], the chattels comprised in the said instrument, and all my right, title, estate, and interest thereunder.

As witness my hand this day of 20 .

Signed by the said C.D, in the presence of – E.F.,

[Residence and occupation]

C.D.

SCHEDULE 7

Section 57

CHATTELS WHICH MAY BE THE SUBJECT OF CUSTOMARY HIRE PURCHASE AGREEMENTS.

Furniture.

Pianos and pianolas.

Gramophones.

Typewriters.

Motor vehicles of all descriptions.

Sewing machines.

Cash registers.

Shearing machines.

Engines.

Pumps and machinery, implements, and accessories for use in pumping.

Windmills.

Milking machines, and all other machinery and implements and accessories for use in

the dairy industry.

Reapers and binders, and all other machinery and implements and accessories thereto

for use in agriculture.

Machinery, implements, and accessories thereto for use in the bootmaking industry.

Electric motors.

Machine printing presses and slug casting machines, type composing machines, and other

machinery accessories and attachments for use in connection with the printing and

bookbinding industry.

Gas stoves, gas geysers, gas washing coppers.

Electrical equipment apparatus, and appliances required in connection with the use of

electric energy.

256 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Computing scales, weighing machines, bread and bacon slicing machines, cheese cutting machines.

Tractors.

Equipment, apparatus and appliances for use in connection with the consumption of

coal gas.

Cinematograph projection machines, and lighting and other equipment peculiar thereto.

Electric ranges and water heaters.

Electric vacuum cleaners, electric refrigerators, radio sets and equipment, bicycles.

Electric washing machines, electric ironing machines, electric floor polishing machines,

petrol driven washing machines

Electric dish washing machines

Piano accordions

Motor mowers, 12 to 21 in.

Electric clothes drying machines and appliances, electric garbage disposal machines and

appliances.

Self-propelled machinery and plant for road-making, earth-moving, tree-moving, or tree-

haulage purposes.

Equipment and appliances for road-making, earth-moving, tree-moving, or tree-haulage

purposes, and attached to or for use with –

(a) Motor vehicles or tractors; or

(b) Self-propelled machinery or plant for roadmaking, earthmoving, tree-

moving, or tree-haulage purposes.

Tanks, equipment, apparatus and appliances for use in connection with the storage,

pumping, and serving of beer (excluding barrels).

Power-operated vehicle hoists and accessories thereto; power-operated lubrication

equipment and accessories thereto.

Television sets and equipment.

Domestic knitting machines.

Heavy duty trailers.

Dry-cleaning equipment of a commercial or industrial type.

Laundry equipment of a commercial or industrial type.

Silos of the type commonly sold to farmers for the storage of grain on farms.

257

CHEQUES ACT 1960

1960/17 (NZ) – 1 January 1961

1

Short title

5

Protection of bankers collecting payment of

2

Protection of bankers paying unindorsed or

cheques

irregularly indorsed cheques

6

Application of certain provisions of principal

3

Rights of bankers collecting cheques not

Act

indorsed by holders

7

Effect of Act

4

Unindorsed cheques as evidence of payment

8

[Spent]

1 Short title

This Act is the Cheques Act 1960, and shall be read together with and
deemed part of the Bills of Exchange Act 1908 (the principal Act).

2 Protection of bankers paying unindorsed or irregularly indorsed cheques

(1) Where a banker in good faith and in the ordinary course of business
pays a cheque drawn on him which is not indorsed or is irregularly indorsed, he
shall not, in doing so, incur any liability by reason only of the absence of, or
irregularity in, indorsement, and he shall be deemed to have paid in due course.
(2) Where a banker in good faith and in the ordinary course of business
pays any such instrument as the following; namely –
(a) A document issued by a customer of his which, though not a bill of
exchange, is intended to enable a person to obtain payment from
him of the sum mentioned in the document; or
(b) A draft payable on demand drawn by him upon himself whether
payable at the head office or some other office of his bank –
he shall not, in doing so, incur any liability by reason only of the absence of, or
irregularity in, indorsement, and the payment shall discharge the instrument.

3 Rights of bankers collecting cheques not indorsed by holders

A banker who gives value for, or has a lien on, a cheque payable to order
which the holder delivers to him for collection without indorsing it shall have
such rights (if any) as he would have had if, upon delivery, the holder had indorsed
it in blank.

4 Unindorsed cheques as evidence of payment

An unindorsed cheque which appears to have been paid by a banker on
whom it is drawn shall, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be sufficient evidence
of the receipt by the payee of the sum payable by the cheque.

5 Protection of bankers collecting payment of cheques

(1) Where a banker in good faith and without negligence –
(a) Receives payment for a customer of an instrument to which this
section applies, or
258 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Having credited a customer ’s account with the amount of any such instrument receives payable of it for himself –
and the customer has no title, or a defective title, to the instrument, the banker shall not incur any liability to the true owner of the instrument by reason only of having received payment of it.
(2) This section applies to the following instruments, namely –
(a) Cheques;
(b) Any document issued by a customer of a banker which, though
not a bill of exchange, is intended to enable a person to obtain
payment from that banker of the sum mentioned in the document;
(c) Any document, not being a bill of exchange, issued by a member of
the Niue Public Service which is intended to enable a person to
obtain payment from a Niue public account of the sum mentioned
in the document;
(d) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(e) Any draft payable on demand drawn by a banker upon himself,
whether payable at the head office or some other office of his bank.
(3) A banker shall not be treated for the purposes of this section as having
been negligent by reason only of his failure to concern himself with the absence
of, or irregularity in indorsement of an instrument.

6 Application of certain provisions of principal Act

The provisions of the principal Act relating to crossed cheques shall, so far
as applicable, have effect in relation to instruments (other than cheques) to which
section 5 applies as they have effect in relation to cheques.

7 Effect of Act

Nothing in this Act shall be deemed to make negotiable any instrument
which, apart from those provisions is not negotiable.

8 [Spent]

259

CHILD ALLOWANCE ACT 1995

1995/203 – 1 January 1996

1

Short title

10

Person allowance is payable to

2

Interpretation

11

Application of child allowance

3

Payment out of Government Account

12

Applying for allowance

4

Amount and payment date

13

Investigation of applications

5

Qualifying child

14

Recovery of allowance

6

Disabled/disadvantaged persons

15

Offences

7

Residence qualifications

16

Proceedings for offences

8

Exemptions

17

Delegation of powers of Director

9

Period allowance is payable

18

Regulations

1 Short title

This is the Child Allowance Act 1995.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“applicant” means the person who makes an application for a child
allowance;
“application” means a form filled out by the applicant when applying for
a child allowance;
“beneficiary” means a person who receives a child allowance in that year;
“Director” means the Director of Community Affairs;
“qualifying child” means a child who meets the criteria under section 5
and includes a stepchild, an adopted child and any child who, if not a
member of the applicant’s family is recognised by the Director as a
member of the applicant’s family;
“recognised school” means a school that is recognised and approved by
the Director for the purposes of this Act;
“Welfare Committee” means the committee constituted under section 5 of
the Pensions and Benefits Act 1991.

3 Payment out of Government Account

Child allowance payable under this Act shall be paid from the Niue
Government Account out of money appropriated by the Niue Assembly for the
purpose.

4 Amount and payment date

(1) The rate of child allowance payable shall be such amount as may be
determined by Cabinet to regulations made under this Act, such amount to be
paid out to a qualifying person as defined in section 10 for each qualifying child
as defined in section 7.
(2) No child allowance shall be payable in respect of any period before the
first payment date pursuant to subclause (1).
260 Niue Laws 2005 Vol 1

5 Qualifying child

(1) A qualifying child shall be a child who qualifies on a residence basis as
set out in section 7 and who is –
(a) Either a Niuean by descent;
(b) A permanent resident of Niue; or
(c) A New Zealand citizen.
(2) A qualifying child may apply for a child allowance who, at the time of
application –
(a) Is ordinarily resident in Niue;
(b) Is not married;
(c) Is financially dependent; and
(d) Is attending a recognised school in Niue.

6 Disabled/disadvantaged persons

(1) Notwithstanding section 5 a disabled/disadvantaged person, who is
not required or is unable to attend school shall be eligible for child allowance up
to the age of 18 years.
(2) The Director on advice of the Welfare Committee shall have sole
discretion to determine whether any child comes within the definition of disabled/
disadvantaged to such an extent as to qualify for the exemptions referred to herein.

7 Residence qualifications

Subject to section 8 an applicant and/or the child the subject of the
application who has been absent from Niue for a continuous period of more than
12 months immediately preceding the application shall not be eligible for child
allowance until a period of 6 months has elapsed since returning to Niue.

8 Exemptions

(1) Any person being the child of an Award Holder who as a direct
consequence of being overseas in the years immediately preceding application
cannot fulfil the residence requirement in section 7 shall not be required to complete
such requirement before being eligible to become a qualifying child.
(2) For the purposes of this section an “Award Holder” is a person who
has taken up study or training overseas which will be of benefit to the Award
Holder and Niue’s development.

9 Period allowance is payable

(1) Child allowance payable in respect of a qualifying child shall, subject
to this Act, commence on the day the application is approved by the Director and
shall continue until the day on which the child leaves a recognised school.
(2) No allowance shall be payable in respect of any period before the date
of coming into force of this Act or its Regulation.
(3) If an application is received by the Director after the closing date as
determined by the Director, the allowance shall not commence until the following
year.
(4) (a) It is the responsibility of the qualifying person to inform the Director in writing of any intended absence from Niue, of the child or themselves.
(b) Failure to inform the Director in writing will result in the loss of future allowances.

Child Allowance Act 1995

261

10 Person allowance is payable to

(1) A qualifying person shall be a parent or guardian whose application
for child allowance has been granted by the Director.
(2) Unless otherwise provided, child allowance shall be payable only to
the mother of a qualifying child (whether application for the allowance has been
made by the mother or father or another person).
(3) The child allowance may be paid to the father of that child, if
(a) The mother of the child has passed away, or has left permanently
for overseas, or has left the family permanently without the child;
and
(b) The child is living with the father and under his care and control.
(4) In any other case the Director may determine that the child allowance
shall be paid to any person who has care and control of the child.
(5) No child allowance shall be payable to any applicant if another
allowance is being paid in another country or received from overseas for that
child.

11 Application of child allowance

(1) Money received by way of child allowance shall be used towards the
maintenance, education, or welfare of the child or children in respect of whom it
is paid, with a sum allocated by Cabinet under regulation, for assisting the school
committee at the school the child attends.
(2) (a) The Director may refuse to grant an allowance or may terminate or
suspend an allowance if the Director is satisfied that the allowance
will not be or has not been properly applied.
(b) Any person aggrieved by a decision of the Director made pursuant
to this section may appeal to the Court for a ruling.
(3) A child allowance cannot be used as collateral or for guaranteeing a
loan.

12 Applying for allowance

An application for a child allowance shall be on an approved application
form and addressed to the Director and shall be by way of statutory declaration in
such form with such information and evidence as the Director may determine.

13 Investigation of applications

(1) Every application shall be investigated by the Director, who shall decide
as to whether the allowance is payable and if so, to whom.
(2) It shall be the duty of every person to answer all questions put by the
Director concerning any application for a child allowance, or concerning any
statements contained in any application for a child allowance.
(3) For the purpose of ascertaining the child’s enrolment and attendance
the Director shall have access to the child’s school attendance records when
required.

14 Recovery of allowance

(1) If any allowance is procured or paid by fraud or false information, the
amount so paid may be recovered from the qualifying person as a debt due to the
Crown.
(2) The Director may make any necessary adjustments in any future
allowance or any other benefit or allowance (whether payable under this or any
other enactment) thereafter becoming payable to the qualifying person.
262 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

15 Offences

Every person who –
(a) Makes any statement knowing it to be false in any material
particular;
(b) Wilfully does or says anything or omits to do or says anything for
the purpose of misleading or attempting to mislead any officer
concerned in the administration of this Act or any other person
whomsoever for the purpose of obtaining (for himself or any other
person) or which results in himself or any other person obtaining
any allowance under this Act;
(c) Demands or accepts from any applicant or from any other person
any fee or other consideration for procuring or endeavouring to
procure any allowance under this Act for that child,
commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 2 months, or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or to both such
imprisonment and fine.

16 Proceedings for offences

(1) Notwithstanding any other enactment, an information for an offence
against this Act may be laid at any time within 5 years after the facts alleged in the
information have been brought to the knowledge of any person concerned in the
administration of this Act.
(2) Every information relating to an offence may, notwithstanding any other
enactment, be heard and determined before the Court.

17 Delegation of powers of Director

(1) The Director may either generally or particularly, delegate to another
officer of the Department such of his powers under this Act or its regulations as
the Director may determine.
(2) Subject to this section and to any general or special directions given or
conditions attached by the Director, the officer to whom any powers are delegated
under this section may exercise those powers in the same manner and with the
same effect as if they had been conferred on him directly by this section and not
by delegation.

18 Regulations

Cabinet may make all necessary regulations to carry out the provisions of
this Act.
263

CITIZENSHIP ACT 1977

1977/61 (NZ) – 1 January1978

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The Citizenship Act of Niue is the Citizenship Act of New Zealand but it has had fewer amendments made to it. This is because none of the New Zealand amendments were extended to Niue. The Niue Assembly has made no amendments to the act. The citizenship enjoyed in Niue is the citizenship of the State of New Zealand. In practical terms therefore the important text is the current Citizenship Act 1977 of New Zealand. It is the Act which is reproduced here. The Citizenship Act 1977 in its Niue form is accessible in Niue Legislation as at 1 August 1990 Vol 1.]

1

Short title and commencement

2

Interpretation

3

Special provisions relating to parentage

4

Administration of Act

4A

Delegation of powers by Secretary

5

Act binds Crown

PART 1

NEW ZEALAND CITIZENSHIP

Acquisition of Citizenship

6 Citizenship by birth

7 Citizenship by descent

8 Citizenship by grant

8 AGrant of citizenship to spouse of New

Zealand citizen (Repealed)

9 Grant of citizenship in special cases

9A Disqualifying convictions

9B Minister may rescind approval at any time

up until applicant becomes citizen

10 Grant of citizenship as of right in certain

cases

11 Minister may require oath or affirmation of

allegiance to be taken

12 Certificate of New Zealand citizenship

Transitional Provisions Relating to Citizenship

13 Existing rights of citizenship protected

14 Applications made under British

Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship

Act 1948 may be proceeded with under this

Act

Loss of Citizenship

15 Renunciation of citizenship

16 Deprivation of New Zealand citizenship [in

special cases]

17 Deprivation of New Zealand citizenship in case of fraud, etc

18 Effect of order

19 Court review of grounds for depriving

person of citizenship

20 Saving of obligations incurred before loss

of citizenship, etc

Miscellaneous Provisions Relating to Citizenship

21 Evidentiary certificates

22 Minister may delegate functions and

powers to overseas representatives

PART 2

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

23 Capacity as to property

24 General provisions as to certificates and

other documents

25 Evidence

26 Discovery of documents held under this

Act

26A Disclosure of citizenship information to

certain specified agencies for certain

purposes

26B Access to information for citizenship

purposes

27 Offences and penalties

28 Regulations

29 Application of Act to Cook Islands, Niue,

and Tokelau

30 Repeals, consequential amendments, and

revocation

SCHEDULES


264 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

To make better provision with respect to the status of New Zealand citizenship, and to consolidate and amend the British Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship Act 1948

1 Short title and commencement

This Act may be cited as the Citizenship Act 1977.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act, unless the context otherwise requires—
“alien” means a person who does not have the status of a New Zealand
citizen, a Commonwealth citizen (British subject), a British protected
person, or an Irish citizen;
“Armed Forces” has the meaning given to it by section 2 of the Defence
Act 1990;
“Crown service under the New Zealand Government” means the service
of the Crown under the Government of New Zealand or under the
Government of a New Zealand mandated territory or New Zealand
trust territory, whether that service is in any part of Her Majesty’s realms
and territories or elsewhere; and includes employment in any of the
State Services, as that term is defined in section 2 of the State Sector Act
1988;
“employee” has the meaning given to it by section 2 of the State Sector Act
1988, except that it includes –
(a) Any chief executive; and
(b) [Repealed]
“Minister” means the Minister of Internal Affairs;
“New Zealand” includes the Cook Islands, Niue, Tokelau, and the Ross
Dependency;
“New Zealand overseas representative” means a diplomatic or consular
representative for New Zealand or a representative of the Government
of New Zealand in any other country; and includes a High
Commissioner for New Zealand in any other country;
“prescribed” means prescribed by regulations made under this Act or by
the Minister;
“Protected state” means a Majesty by Order in Council to be a protected
state for the purposes of the British Nationality Act 1948 (UK); and
includes the New Hebrides and Canton Island;
“Protectorate” means a State or territory that is declared by Her Majesty
by Order in Council to be a protectorate for the purposes of the British
Nationality Act 1948 (UK);
“Secretary” means the Secretary for Internal Affairs.
(2) References in this Act to a Commonwealth country include references
to every territory for the international relations of which that country is responsible.
(3) For the purposes of this Act, –
(a) A person born aboard a registered ship or aircraft shall be deemed
to have been born in the place in which the ship or aircraft was
registered;
(b) A person born aboard an unregistered ship or aircraft of the
Government of a country shall be deemed to have been born in
that country;
(c) A person shall be deemed to be of full capacity if he is not of unsound
mind.

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

265

3 Special provisions relating to parentage

(1) For the purposes of this Act a person shall, in the absence of evidence
to the contrary, be presumed to be the father of another person if—
(a) he is or was married to, or in a civil union or a de facto relationship
with, that other person’s mother at any time during the period
commencing with that other person’s conception and ending with
that other person’s birth; or
(b) His paternity of that other person has been established by one or
more of the types of evidence specified by section 8 of the Status of
Children Act 1969 –
and (but without limiting subsection (2) of this section) the term “father”, when
used in this Act, shall be construed accordingly.
(2) For the purposes of this Act a person shall be deemed to be the child of
a New Zealand citizen if –
(a) He or she has been adopted by that citizen, in New Zealand, by an
adoption order within the meaning of and made under the Adoption
Act 1955; or
(aa) He or she has been legally adopted by that citizen, in Niue, Tokelau,
or the Cook Islands, by an adoption order that has the same
operation and effect as an adoption order made under the Adoption
Act 1955; or
(b) He or she has been adopted by that citizen, outside New Zealand,
by an adoption to which section 17 of the Adoption Act 1955 applies,
and either –
(i) that adoption took place before the commencement of the
Citizenship Amendment Act 1992; or
(ii) at the time that adoption order was made he or she had not
attained the age of 14 years; or
(ba) He or she has been adopted by that citizen, outside New Zealand,
by an adoption order which has been certified by the competent
authority of the Contracting State in which the adoption was made
as being an adoption made in accordance with the Convention on
Protection of Children and Co-operation in Respect of Intercountry
Adoption –
and in any such case –
(c) The terms “father”, “mother”, and “parent”, when used in this Act,
shall be construed accordingly;
(d) The person shall be deemed to have been born when and where
the adoption order was made:
Provided that, on the discharge for any reason of the adoption order in accordance
with section 20 of the Adoption Act 1955 (or in accordance with the law relating to
the discharge of adoption orders in Niue, Tokelau, or the Cook Islands), the person
shall cease to be deemed to be the child of that citizen.
(2A) Nothing in the Adoption Act 1955 shall confer on a person who has
been adopted by a New Zealand citizen in circumstances other than those specified
in subsection (2) of this section any greater right to New Zealand citizenship than
that person would have had if that person had not been adopted.
(2B) For the purposes of this Act, a person is deemed to be the child of a
person entitled to be in New Zealand indefinitely if—
266 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) He or she has been adopted in New Zealand on or after 1
January 2006, by an adoption order within the meaning of and
made under the Adoption Act 1955, by a person who, at the
time of the adoption, is entitled in terms of the Immigration
Act 1987 to be in New Zealand indefinitely, or entitled to reside
indefinitely in the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau; or
(b) He or she has been legally adopted in the Cook Islands, Niue, or
Tokelau on or after 1 January 2006, by an adoption order that has
the same operation and effect as an adoption order made under the
Adoption Act 1955, by a person who, at the time of the adoption, is
entitled in terms of the Immigration Act 1987 to be in New Zealand
indefinitely, or entitled to reside indefinitely in the Cook Islands,
Niue, or Tokelau, –
and, in any such case –
(c) The terms father, mother, and parent, when used in this Act, are to
be construed accordingly, and
(d) The person is deemed to have been born when and where the
adoption order was made; but
(e) On the discharge for any reason of the adoption in accordance with
section 20 of the Adoption Act 1955, or in accordance with the law
relating to the discharge of adoption orders in the Cook Islands,
Niue, or Tokelau, the person ceases to be deemed to be the child of
the person entitled to be in New Zealand indefinitely.
(3) References in this Act to the status or description of the father or mother
of a person at the time of that person’s birth shall, in relation to a person born after
the death of his father or mother (as the case may require), be construed as referring
to the status or description of the father or mother at the time of his or her death.
(4) Where the relevant parent died before, and the person was born on or
after, the 1st day of January 1949, the status or description that would have been
applicable to the parent had he or she died on or after the 1st day of January 1949
shall be deemed to be the status or description applicable to him or her at the time
of his or her death.
(5) Where the relevant parent died before, and the birth occurs on or after,
the 1st day of January 1978, the status or description that would have been
applicable to the parent had he or she died on or after that date shall be deemed to
be the status or description applicable to him or her at the time of his or her death.
(5A) In subsection 3(1)(a), de facto relationship has the same meaning as in section
2D of the Property (Relationships) Act 1976, except that—
(a) The reference to 18 years in subsection (1)(a) of that section is to be
read as a reference to 16 years; and
(b) A person who has attained the age of 16 years but who is younger
than 18 years may be treated as having a de facto relationship with
another person only if –
(i) the person is under the guardianship of a court, and the court
has on an application for the purpose consented to the
relationship; or
(ii) in the case of a person not under the guardianship of a court,
the person’s parents and guardians have consented to the
relationship.
(6) In subsection (2)(ba), Contracting State has the same meaning as in the
Adoption (Intercountry) Act 1997.

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

267

4 Administration of Act

Subject to the control of the Minister, the Secretary for Internal Affairs is
responsible for the administration of this Act.

4A Delegation of powers by Secretary

(1) The Secretary may from time to time, by writing under the Secretary’s
hand, either generally or particularly, delegate to such officer or officers of the
Department of Internal Affairs as the Secretary thinks fit all or any of the powers
and functions exercisable by the Secretary under this Act or under any regulations
made under this Act, other than the power of delegation conferred by this section.
(2) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions attached
by the Secretary, the officer to whom any powers are delegated under this section
may exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same effect as if they
had been conferred on the officer directly by this section and not by delegation.
(3) Every person purporting to act pursuant to any delegation under this
section shall be presumed to be acting in accordance with its terms in the absence
of evidence to the contrary.
(4) Any delegation under this section may be made to a specified officer
or to officers of a specified class, or may be made to the holder for the time being
of a specified office or class of office.
(5) Any delegation under this section shall be revocable at will, and no
such delegation shall prevent the exercise of any power or function by the Secretary.
(6) Any such delegation shall, until revoked, continue in force according
to its tenor, notwithstanding the fact that the Secretary by whom it was made may
have ceased to hold office, and shall continue to have effect as if made by the
successor in office of that Secretary.

5 Act binds Crown

This Act binds the Crown.
PART 1
NEW ZEALAND CITIZENSHIP

Acquisition of Citizenship

6 Citizenship by birth

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a person is a New Zealand citizen by birth if –
(a) The person was born in New Zealand on or after l January 1949
and before 1 January 2006; or
(b) The person was born in New Zealand on or after 1 January 2006,
and, at the time of the person’s birth, at least one of the person’s
parents was –
(i) a New Zealand citizen; or
(ii) entitled in terms of the Immigration Act 1987 to be in New
Zealand indefinitely, or entitled to reside indefinitely in the
Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau.
(2) A person shall not be a New Zealand citizen by virtue of this section if,
at the time of his birth,—
(a) His father or mother was a person upon whom any immunity from
jurisdiction was conferred by or under the Diplomatic Privileges
and Immunities Act 1968 or the Consular Privileges and Immunities
Act 1971 or in any other way, and neither of his parents was a New
Zealand citizen; or
268 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) His father and mother were enemy aliens and the birth occurred in a place then under occupation by the enemy.
(3) Despite subsections (1) and (2), –
(a) Every person born in New Zealand on or after 1 January 1978 is a
New Zealand citizen by birth if the person would otherwise be
stateless;
(b) A person is deemed to be a New Zealand citizen by birth if—
(i) the person, having recently been born, has been found
abandoned in New Zealand; and
(ii) investigations have failed to establish the identity of at least
one of the person’s parents.
(4) Notwithstanding section 7 of this Act, a person born outside New
Zealand shall be deemed to be a New Zealand citizen otherwise than by descent
if that person’s father or mother is then—
(a) A New Zealand citizen, or a New Zealand citizen by descent,
pursuant to this Act; and
(b) Either—
(i) a head of mission or head of post within the meaning of the
Foreign Affairs Act 1988; or
(ii) an employee in any part of the State services, or a member of
the Armed Forces, on service overseas; or
(iia) a person working overseas for the public service of Niue,
Tokelau, or the Cook Islands; or
(iii) an officer or employee of New Zealand Trade and Enterprise
(as established by the New Zealand Trade and Enterprise Act
2003) on service overseas; or
(iv) an officer or employee of the New Zealand Tourism Board (as
established by the New Zealand Tourism Board Act 1991) on
service overseas.
(5) Despite section 7, a person is a New Zealand citizen by birth if—
(a) The person is born in the Independent State of Samoa; and
(b) But for reasons of medical necessity requiring the mother to travel
from Tokelau to the Independent State of Samoa to give birth to the
person, the person would have been born in Tokelau; and
(c) At the time of the person’s birth the person would have been a
New Zealand citizen by birth under subsection (1), had the person
been born on that date in Tokelau.
(6) A person who is a New Zealand citizen by birth does not lose his or her
New Zealand citizenship by reason of the person being adopted by a parent or
parents who are neither—
(a) New Zealand citizens; nor
(b) Persons entitled to reside indefinitely in New Zealand in terms of
the Immigration Act 1987 or entitled to reside indefinitely in the
Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau.

7 Citizenship by descent

(1) Every person born outside New Zealand on or after 1 January 1978 is a
New Zealand citizen by descent if, at the time of the person’s birth,—
(a) His or her mother or father was a New Zealand citizen otherwise
than by descent; or
(b) His or her mother or father was a New Zealand citizen by descent,
and the person would otherwise be stateless.

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

269
(2) A person who is a New Zealand citizen by virtue of subsection (1) may apply for his or her citizenship status to be registered in accordance with regulations made under this Act.
(3) For the purposes of this section, the Secretary may issue a certificate stating a person’s status under this section and, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, a certificate to such effect signed by the Secretary, or by a person authorised for the purpose by the Secretary, shall be sufficient evidence of the matters stated in the certificate.
(4) The citizenship of any New Zealand citizen by descent that has lapsed
before the commencement of the Citizenship Amendment Act 2000 is reinstated
with effect from the time it lapsed.

8 Citizenship by grant

(1) The Minister may authorise the grant of New Zealand citizenship to
any person, including a person who may be a New Zealand citizen by descent, who—
(a) Has attained the age of 16 years; and
(b) Is of full capacity; and
(c) Applies for citizenship in the prescribed manner; and
(d) Satisfies the Minister that he or she meets each of the requirements
specified in subsection (2).
(2) The requirements referred to in subsection (1)(d) are as follows:
(a) That the applicant is entitled in terms of the Immigration Act 1987
to be in New Zealand indefinitely;
(b) That the applicant was present in New Zealand –
(i) for a minimum of 1 350 days during the 5 years immediately
preceding the date of the application; and
(ii) for at least 240 days in each of those 5 years,
being days during which the applicant was entitled in terms of the Immigration
Act 1987 to be in New Zealand indefinitely –
(c) That the applicant is of good character;
(d) That the applicant has sufficient knowledge of the responsibilities
and privileges attaching to New Zealand citizenship;
(e) That the applicant has sufficient knowledge of the English language;
(f) That the applicant intends, if granted New Zealand citizenship,
either—
(i) to continue to reside in New Zealand; or
(ii) to enter into or continue in Crown service under the New
Zealand Government, or service under an international
organisation of which the New Zealand Government is a
member, or service in the employment of a person, company,
society, or other body of persons resident or established in New
Zealand.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2)(a), a person will not be treated as
entitled to be in New Zealand indefinitely if—
(a) Requirements have been imposed under the Immigration Act 1987
on the person’s entitlement to reside in New Zealand indefinitely;
and
(b) Those requirements have not been met in full or cancelled at the
time of the person’s application for citizenship.
270 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(4) The Minister may, after consultation with the Minister of Immigration, – (a) Waive the requirement in subsection (2)(a) if satisfied that an applicant is entitled to reside indefinitely in the Cook Islands, Niue,
or Tokelau;
(b) Waive the requirement in subsection (2)(b) if satisfied that an
applicant was present in the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau –
(i) for a minimum of 1 350 days during the 5 years immediately
preceding the date of the application; and
(ii) for at least 240 days in each of those 5 years,—
being days during which the applicant was entitled to reside indefinitely in the
Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau.
(5) For the purposes of subsection (2)(b), the Minister may treat the
applicant as having been in New Zealand for any period within the period of 5
years immediately preceding the date of application for citizenship during which—
(a) The applicant was in Crown service under the New Zealand
Government; or
(b) The applicant was outside New Zealand because the applicant was
accompanying his or her spouse or civil union or de facto partner
who was a New Zealand citizen in Crown service under the New
Zealand Government.
(6) For the purposes of subsection (4)(b), the Minister may treat the
applicant as having been present in the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau for any
period within the period of 5 years immediately preceding the date of the
application for citizenship during which—
(a) The applicant served in the public service of the Government of
the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau; or
(b) The applicant was outside New Zealand because the applicant was
accompanying his or her spouse or civil union or de facto partner
who was a New Zealand citizen serving in the public service of the
Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau.
(7) If the Minister is satisfied in a particular case that there are exceptional
circumstances particular to the applicant that would justify such a course, the
Minister may accept the presence by the applicant for a lesser number of days as
being sufficient compliance with—
(a) The requirements of subsection (2)(b), so long as the applicant—
(i) was physically present in New Zealand for not less than 450
days during the 20-month period immediately preceding the
date of the application for citizenship; and
(ii) was entitled in terms of the Immigration Act 1987 to be in New
Zealand indefinitely during each of those 450 days.
(b) The requirements of subsection (4)(b), so long as the applicant—
(i) was physically present in the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau
for not less than 450 days during the 20-month period
immediately preceding the date of the application for
citizenship; and
(ii) was entitled to be in the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau
indefinitely during each of those 450 days.
(8) The Minister may waive the requirement in subsection (2)(e) if satisfied
in a particular case that, because of the applicant’s age or standard of education,
or for any other reason personal to the applicant, the applicant would suffer undue
hardship if compliance with the requirement of that provision were insisted upon.
(9) For the purposes of subsection (2)(f),—

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

271
(a) The intention referred to in subsection (2)(f)(i) must be a continuing intention throughout the period from the date of application for citizenship until the date that the applicant becomes a citizen under section 12;
(b) the Minister may treat an applicant as intending to continue to reside in New Zealand if the applicant intends to accompany his or her New Zealand citizen spouse or civil union or de facto partner on Crown service for the New Zealand Government or public service for the Government of the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau.

9 Grant of citizenship in special cases

(1) Without limiting anything in section 8, the Minister may, upon
application in the prescribed manner, authorise the grant of New Zealand citizenship to any person, including a person who may be a New Zealand citizen by descent,—
(a) Who has not yet attained the age of 16 years; or
(b) Whose father or mother was, at the time of that person’s birth, a
New Zealand citizen by descent; or
(c) If the Minister is satisfied that granting a certificate of New Zealand
citizenship to the applicant would be in the public interest because
of exceptional circumstances of a humanitarian or other nature
relating to the applicant; or
(d) If the person would otherwise be stateless.
(2) In considering whether to authorise the grant of New Zealand
citizenship to any person under subsection (1), the Minister—
(a) May have regard to such of the requirements of section 8(2) (as
subject to section 8(3) to (9)) as the Minister thinks fit; and
(b) Must have regard to the requirements of section 9A (1) (but subject
to the Minister ’s discretion under section 9A(2) and (3)).

9A Disqualifying convictions

(1) Except as provided in subsection (2), the Minister must not authorise a
grant of citizenship under section 8 or section 9 to a person who has been convicted
of an offence if—
(a) The person was sentenced on conviction to—
(i) a term of imprisonment of 5 years or more; or
(ii) an indefinite term of imprisonment capable of running for 5
years or more; or
(b) Within the preceding 7 years the person was subject to a sentence
of imprisonment of less than 5 years or was subject to release under
subpart 2 of Part 1 of the Parole Act 2002; or
(c) Within the preceding 3 years the person was convicted of an offence
but did not receive a sentence of imprisonment.
(2) The Minister may however authorise a grant of citizenship to a person
to whom subsection (1) applies and who otherwise meets the requirements of
section 8 or section 9 if satisfied that there are exceptional circumstances relating
to the conviction such that a grant of citizenship should not be precluded.
(3) Nothing in this section limits the Minister ’s discretion to refuse a grant
of citizenship if the Minister is not satisfied that the applicant is of good character.
272 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

9B Minister may rescind approval at any time up until applicant becomes citizen

Notwithstanding that the Minister may have authorised a grant of citizenship under section 8 or section 9, the Minister may rescind that authorisation at any time before the date that the person becomes a citizen under section 12, if no longer satisfied that the person meets the requirements for a grant of citizenship.

10 Grant of citizenship as of right in certain cases

(1) Notwithstanding anything in section 8 or section 9 of this Act, the
Minister shall, upon application made to him in the prescribed manner, authorise
the grant of New Zealand citizenship to any person who was born before the 1st
day of January 1978 if, at the time of that person’s birth, his mother was a New
Zealand citizen otherwise than by descent.
(2) This section does not apply to a person who has previously been
deprived of New Zealand citizenship by order under section 16 or section 17, or
renounced his or her citizenship under section 15.

11 Minister may require oath or affirmation of allegiance to be taken

(1) The Minister may, in such case or class of cases as the Minister thinks
fit, make the grant of New Zealand citizenship conditional upon the applicant
taking an oath of allegiance in the form specified in Schedule 1, or making an
affirmation to similar effect.
(2) Unless the Minister agrees otherwise, the oath or affirmation must be
taken or made at a public citizenship ceremony.

12 Certificate of New Zealand citizenship

(1) Where the Minister authorises the grant of New Zealand citizenship to
any person, the Secretary shall issue to that person a certificate of New Zealand
citizenship in the prescribed form.
(2) A person to whom a certificate of New Zealand citizenship is issued
under subsection (1) of this section shall be a New Zealand citizen as from the
specified date.
(3) Where a certificate of New Zealand citizenship is issued to a person
who is a New Zealand citizen by descent, he shall cease to have that status as
from the specified date.
(4) For the purposes of subsections (2) and (3) of this section the specified
date shall be –
(a) In the case of a person required under section 11 of this Act to take
an oath of allegiance, the date on which he takes that oath or makes
an affirmation to the same effect;
(b) In every other case, the date specified in the certificate.

Transitional Provisions Relating to Citizenship

13 Existing rights of citizenship protected

(1) Notwithstanding the repeal of the British Nationality and New Zealand
Citizenship Act 1948 by section 30 of this Act, every person who, by virtue of that
Act, was a New Zealand citizen immediately before the commencement of this
Act, shall, subject to the succeeding provisions of this Part of this Act, continue to
be a New Zealand citizen.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) of this section, a person who, by virtue
of the British Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship Act 1948, was, immediately
before the commencement of this Act, a New Zealand citizen by descent only,
shall, for the purposes of this Act, be deemed to be a New Zealand citizen by
descent only.

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

273
(3) Without limiting subsection (1) or subsection (2) of this section, but subject to subsection (4) of this section, every person born outside New Zealand on or after the 1st day of January 1949 but before the 1st day of January 1978 shall be a New Zealand citizen by descent if –
(a) In any case, his father was a New Zealand citizen at the time of that person’s birth; or
(b) In the case of a person born on or after the 1st day of January 1970 (being the date of the commencement of the Status of Children Act
1969), his mother was a New Zealand citizen at the time of his birth.
(4) A person shall not be a New Zealand citizen by virtue of subsection (3)
of this section if that person’s relevant parent was a New Zealand citizen by descent
only, unless—
(a) That person or his relevant parent was born in a protectorate,
protected state, mandated territory, or trust territory, or any place
in a foreign country where by treaty, capitulation, grant, usage,
sufferance, or other lawful means Her Majesty then had jurisdiction
over British subjects; or
(b) In the case of a person born in a place other than a place mentioned
in paragraph (a) of this subsection, his birth [or citizenship by
descent] is registered, in accordance with regulations made under
this Act, before that person has attained the age of 16 years; or
(c) The relevant parent of that person was, at the time of the person’s
birth, in Crown service under the New Zealand Government.

14 Applications made under British Nationality and New Zealand

Citizenship Act 1948 may be proceeded with under this Act

If a person has, before the commencement of this Act,—
(a) Applied for registration as a New Zealand citizen; or
(b) Given notice of his intention to apply for a certificate of
naturalisation; or
(c) Applied for a certificate of naturalisation –
in accordance with the provisions of the British Nationality and New Zealand
Citizenship Act 1948, the application (if it has not been finally determined under
that Act) or notice may be dealt with in accordance with this Act as if it were an
application for the grant of New Zealand citizenship under this Act.

Loss of Citizenship

15 Renunciation of citizenship

(1) A New Zealand citizen who has attained the age of 18 years and is of
full capacity and who is recognised by the law of another country as a citizen of
that country may, at any time, make a declaration of renunciation of his New
Zealand citizenship in the prescribed manner.
(2) Subject to subsection (3) of this section, the Minister shall cause every
declaration made under subsection (1) of this section to be registered in the
prescribed manner, and, as from the date of that registration, the declarant shall
cease to be a New Zealand citizen.
(3) The Minister may decline to register a declaration of renunciation if –
(a) The declarant is resident in New Zealand; or
(b) A state of war exists between New Zealand and any other country.
(4) A person who has ceased to be a New Zealand citizen under this section
may regain New Zealand citizenship only by way of a grant of citizenship under
section 8 or section 8A or section 9.
274 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

16 Deprivation of New Zealand citizenship [in special cases]

Subject to section 19 of this Act, the Minister may, by order, deprive a person
of his New Zealand citizenship if he is satisfied that the person has, while a New
Zealand citizen and while of or over the age of 18 years and of full capacity,—
(a) Acquired the nationality or citizenship of another country by any
voluntary and formal act, and acted in a manner that is contrary to
the interests of New Zealand; or
(b) Voluntarily exercised any of the privileges or performed any of the
duties of another nationality or citizenship possessed by him in a
manner that is contrary to the interests of New Zealand.

17 Deprivation of New Zealand citizenship in case of fraud, etc

(1) This section applies to a New Zealand citizen who has acquired that
citizenship –
(a) By registration under the British Nationality and New Zealand
Citizenship Act 1948; or
(b) By naturalisation under that Act; or
(c) By grant under this Act or the Citizenship (Western Samoa) Act
1982.
(2) Subject to section 19 of this Act, the Minister may, by order, deprive a
New Zealand citizen to whom this section applies of his New Zealand citizenship
if he is satisfied that the registration, naturalisation, grant, or any grant requirement
was procured by fraud, false representation, or wilful concealment of relevant
information, or by mistake.
(3) The Minister may not deprive a person of New Zealand citizenship
under subsection (2) if –
(a) The citizenship was acquired by mistake; and
(b) To deprive the person of that citizenship would leave the person
stateless.

18 Effect of order

A person in respect of whom an order is made under section 16 or section
17 of this Act shall cease to be a New Zealand citizen as from the date of the order.

19 Court review of grounds for depriving person of citizenship

(1) Before making an order under section 16 or section 17 of this Act
depriving any person of New Zealand citizenship, the Minister shall serve on that
person a notice –
(a) Stating that he intends to make such an order; and
(b) Citing the section of this Act under which he considers that he has
grounds to make such an order; and
(c) Specifying the grounds on which he intends to make such an order;
and
(d) Advising the person of his right to have the matter reviewed by the
Court in accordance with the succeeding provisions of this section.
(2) Every person upon whom a notice is served under subsection (1) of
this section may, within 28 days after it is served on him, apply to the High Court
for a declaration that there are insufficient grounds to justify the making of an
order under section 16 or, as the case may require, section 17 of this Act depriving
the applicant of New Zealand citizenship; and the Court may make or refuse to
make such a declaration accordingly.
(3) Notwithstanding any of the foregoing provisions of this section, in any

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

275
case where the whereabouts of the person concerned are unknown or for any other reason service on him of a notice under this section is not practicable, the Minister may apply to the Court for the dispensing of the requirement to serve notice; and, in such a case, if the Court dispenses with that requirement, it shall proceed to consider the merits of the case, in accordance with the provisions of this section, as if the person concerned had applied to the Court for a declaration of the kind referred to in subsection (2) of this section.
(4) Where the Court makes such a declaration, the Minister shall not thereafter, without fresh cause, make an order under section 16 or section 17 of this Act depriving the applicant of New Zealand citizenship.
(5) [Repealed]
(6) Subject to the succeeding provisions of this section, the procedure in
respect of an application under this section shall be in accordance with the rules
of Court.
(7) When hearing any application under this section the Court may receive
as evidence any statement, document, information, or matter that, in the opinion
of the Court, may assist it to deal justly with the application before it, whether or
not the same would be otherwise admissible in proceedings before the Court.
(8) Where the Court is satisfied that it is desirable to do so by reason of the
confidential nature of any evidence submitted or to be submitted to it in respect of
any application under this section, the Court may, of its own motion or on the
application of any party to the proceedings, –
(a) Take or hear the evidence in private;
(b) Make an order prohibiting the publication of any report or account
of the whole or any part of any such evidence (whether heard or
taken in public or private).
(9) The determination of the High Court on any such application shall be
final.

20 Saving of obligations incurred before loss of citizenship, etc

A person who ceases to be a New Zealand citizen shall not thereby be
discharged from any obligation, duty, or liability in respect of any act or thing
done or omitted to be done before he ceased to be a New Zealand citizen.

Miscellaneous Provisions Relating to Citizenship

21 Evidentiary certificates

(1) Any person who wishes to obtain confirmation of whether he or she is
or is not a New Zealand citizen may apply to the Minister in the prescribed manner
for a certificate confirming the person’s status in that respect.
(2) The Minister shall, if satisfied that any such person is or is not a New
Zealand citizen, issue a certificate to that effect.
(3) A certificate issued under this section shall, unless it is proved that the
issue of the certificate was procured by fraud, false representation, or the wilful
concealment of relevant information, or was the result of administrative error, be
evidence that the person named in the certificate was or was not, on the date on
which the certificate was issued, a New Zealand citizen, but without prejudice to
any evidence that he or she was or was not a New Zealand citizen at an earlier
date.
276 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

22 Minister may delegate functions and powers to overseas representatives (1) The Minister may from time to time, by writing under his hand, authorise any New Zealand overseas representative in any country to perform and exercise in that country any of the Minister ’s functions and powers under

this Part of this Act.
(2) In the performance or exercise of any such functions or powers, the
New Zealand overseas representative shall act in accordance with all directions
in that behalf given to him by the Minister, whether generally or in a particular
case.
(3) Any authority and any directions under this section may be given to a specified person, or to the holder for the time being of a specified office.
PART 2
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

23 Capacity as to property

(1) Subject to subsection (2) of this section and to any other enactment,
every person who is not a New Zealand citizen shall be entitled to take, acquire,
hold, and dispose of real or personal property in the same manner in all respects
as if he were a New Zealand citizen.
(2) Subsection (1) of this section shall not—
(a) Qualify an alien for any office, or for any parliamentary or other
franchise, for which he is not otherwise qualified;
(b) Qualify an alien to be the owner of a ship registered in New Zealand,
or of a share in any such ship;
(c) Entitle an alien to acquire property without any consent required
under the Overseas Investment Act 2005;
(d) Entitle a person to any right or privilege as a New Zealand citizen,
except the rights and privileges conferred on him in respect of
property by that subsection.

24 General provisions as to certificates and other documents

(1) For the purposes of this section the term document means a certificate
or other document issued under this Act; and includes a certificate or other
document issued under any enactment referred to in section 25(1) of this Act; and
also includes a duplicate of any such certificate or other document.
(2) No person shall alter or deface a document otherwise than pursuant to
this Act.
(3) Every person to whom a document is or has been issued shall, on the
expiry or revocation of the document, or of the exemption or condition or status
evidenced by it, deliver the document to the Secretary.
(4) If a document that has been damaged to the extent that it is no longer
legible is returned to the Secretary, or if the Secretary is satisfied that a document
has been destroyed, lost, or stolen, the Secretary shall, upon application by the
person to whom the document was issued and upon payment of the prescribed
fee, issue a duplicate of the document.

25 Evidence

(1) Every document purporting to be a notice, certificate, or declaration,
or an entry in a register, or a subscription of an oath of allegiance given, granted,
or made under this Act, the British Nationality and Status of Aliens (in New
Zealand) Act 1923 or any enactment repealed by that Act, the British Nationality
and Status of Aliens (in New Zealand) Act 1928, or the Registration of Aliens Act
1917, or any enactment repealed by section 30 of this Act shall be received in

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

277
evidence, and shall, unless the contrary is proved, be deemed to have been given, granted, or made by or on whose behalf it purports to have been given, granted, or made.
(2) Evidence of any document to which subsection (1) of this section applies may be given by production of a document purporting to be certified as a true copy thereof by such person and in such manner as may be prescribed.
(3) Any entry in a register made under this Act or any other Act referred to in subsection (1) of this section shall be received as evidence of the matters stated in the entry.
(4) For the purposes of this Act, a certificate given by or on behalf of the Minister that a person was at any time in Crown service under the New Zealand Government shall be conclusive evidence of that fact.

26 Discovery of documents held under this Act

(1) Notwithstanding section 17 or section 27 of the Crown Proceedings
Act 1950, but subject to subsection (2) of this section, no Court shall have power in any civil proceedings to require the Crown to make discovery of a document or to produce a document for inspection if the document is held by or on behalf of the Crown for any of the purposes of this Act.
(2) Subsection (1) of this section does not apply to proceedings relating to
any matter arising under this Act to which the Crown is a party.

26A Disclosure of citizenship information to certain specified agencies for certain purposes

(1) The purpose of this section is to authorise the disclosure of citizenship information to certain specified agencies for certain purposes.
(2) The Secretary and the chief executive of a specified agency listed in the first column of Schedule 4 may enter into an agreement for the disclosure by the Secretary to the chief executive of citizenship information only for the purpose described in the second column in relation to the specified agency.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2), an agreement made in relation to
citizenship information to be used to verify whether a person is eligible to hold a
New Zealand passport, must be entered into by the Secretary in his or her capacity
as the holder of citizenship information with himself or herself in the capacity as
the holder of information under the Passports Act 1992.
(4) An agreement entered into under subsection (2) may be varied by the
Secretary and the chief executive.
(5) The Secretary may disclose citizenship information to the chief executive
only in accordance with Schedule 4 and an agreement entered into under subsection
(2).
(5A) Despite anything in this section, the Secretary may disclose information about a person’s citizenship status or the citizenship status of a person’s parent or parents to the Registrar-General appointed under section 79 (1) of the Births, Deaths, and Marriages Registration Act 1995 for the purpose of recording that person’s citizenship status on his or her birth record.
(6) In this section, –
“citizenship information” means information held by the Secretary that
relates to the acquisition or loss of citizenship by, or the citizenship
status of, any person; and includes information as to any change of
identity or gender
“specified agency” has the meaning given to it by section 97 of the Privacy
Act 1993.
278 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

26B Access to information for citizenship purposes

(1) The Secretary and the chief executive of the Department of Labour (the
chief executive) may enter into an agreement for access by the Secretary, or officers
of the Department of Internal Affairs designated by the Secretary for the purpose,
to information held by the chief executive by virtue of being responsible for the
administration of the Immigration Act 1987 that is needed for or relevant to –
(a) Citizenship investigations and the accurate assessment of
applications for a grant of citizenship; or
(b) Determining whether a person is a New Zealand citizen by birth.
(2) An agreement entered into under subsection (1) may be varied by the
Secretary and the chief executive.
(3) Before entering into an agreement under subsection (1), or varying an
agreement under subsection (2), the Secretary and the chief executive must consult
with the Privacy Commissioner on the terms of the agreement or variation.
(4) The Privacy Commissioner may require the Secretary and the chief
executive to review an agreement under this section, and report on the result of
the review to the Privacy Commissioner, at intervals not shorter than 12 months.
(5) For citizenship purposes, the Secretary or designated officers of the
Department of Internal Affairs may access information held by the chief executive
only in accordance with an agreement entered into under this section.

27 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person commits an offence, and is liable on conviction on
indictment to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years or a fine not exceeding
$15,000, or both, who –
(a) For the purpose of procuring anything to be done or not to be done
under this Act, –
(i) makes any statement that he or she knows to be false in a
material particular; or
(ii) recklessly makes any statement that is false in a material
particular; or
(b) Knowingly or recklessly submits false or forged documents to
support a citizenship application; or
(c) In contravention of section 24, knowingly—
(i) alters or defaces a document; or
(ii) fails to deliver a document; or
(d) Knowingly or recklessly lends or parts with a document (as defined
in section 24(1)) for unlawful purposes; or
(e) Knowingly resists, obstructs, or deceives any person who is
exercising or attempting to exercise any function or power imposed
or conferred under this Act.
(2) Every person commits an offence, and is liable on conviction on
indictment to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 10 years or a fine not
exceeding $50,000, or both, who, knowingly and without reasonable excuse,—
(a) Records, deletes, or alters any entry in a citizenship register or
database; or
(b) Takes a citizenship document (including any blank certificate) from
where it is officially kept; or
(c) Issues a citizenship document to a person who has no lawful
entitlement to the document.

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

279

28 Regulations

(1) The Governor-General may from time to time, by Order in Council,
make regulations for all or any of the following purposes –
(a) Prescribing anything that under this Act is to be prescribed;
(b) Providing for the registration of anything required or authorised
under this Act to be registered;
(c) Providing for the administration and taking of oaths of allegiance
under this Act, prescribing the time within which oaths of allegiance
shall be taken, and providing for the registration of oaths of
allegiance;
(d) Providing for the giving of any notice required or authorised to be
given to any person under this Act;
(e) Providing for the cancellation and amendment of certificates of
naturalisation and certificates of New Zealand citizenship, and for
the cancellation of the registration of such certificates, relating to
persons deprived of New Zealand citizenship under this Act, and
providing for the surrender of such certificates by such persons;
(f) Providing for the registration, by officers in the service of the New
Zealand Government –
(i) of the births and deaths of persons of any class or description
born or dying in any Commonwealth country, or in a protected
state, or in any foreign country;
(ii) of citizenship by descent of persons born in any Commonwealth
country, or in a protected state, or in any foreign country.
(g) Enabling the births and deaths, and the citizenship by descent, of
New Zealand citizens and British protected persons to be registered
in any country in which the New Zealand Government has for the
time being no overseas representatives –
(i) By persons serving in the diplomatic, consular, or other foreign
service of any country that, by arrangement with the New
Zealand Government, has undertaken to represent that
Government’s interests in that country; or
(ii) By any person authorised in that behalf by the Governor-
General.
(h) Providing for the keeping of records, registers, and indexes for the
purposes of this Act, and enabling persons to inspect and make
copies of any entry in any such record, register, or index –
(i) Prescribing the fees payable, or the rate at which fees are to be
calculated, and providing for the recovery and application of such
fees, in respect of—
(i) any application made under this Act;
(ii) the registration of any document under this Act;
(iii) the making of any declaration under this Act;
(iv) the taking of an oath of allegiance under this Act;
(v) the grant of any certificate under this Act;
(vi) the issue of any copy (whether certified or not) of any notice,
certificate, order, declaration, or entry given, granted, or made
under this Act;
(vii) the inspection of any record, register, or index kept under this
Act;
280 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(viia) the giving of written advice or the provision of written information, by or on behalf of the Secretary and whether generally or in relation to a particular case, in respect of all or any of the following:
(A) The eligibility of any person for citizenship by descent; (B) The acquisition by any person of citizenship;
(C) The status of any person under this Act;
(viib) The issue of a certificate under section 7 (3) of this Act;
(viii) Any other matter arising under this Act;
(j) [Repealed]
(k) Prescribing offences in respect of the contravention of or non­
compliance with any regulations made under this Act, and
prescribing the amount of any fine that may be imposed in respect
of any such offence, being an amount not exceeding $200 and, where
the offence is a continuing one, a further amount not exceeding $20
for every day during which the offence has continued;
(l) Providing for such other matters as are contemplated by or necessary
for giving full effect to the provisions of this Act and for the due
administration thereof.
(2) Every fee prescribed by or under regulations made under this section
shall be reasonable, having regard to the costs and expenses incurred and borne
by or on behalf of the Secretary in respect of the matter for which the fee is payable.

29 Application of Act to Cook Islands, Niue, and Tokelau

(1) Whereas in accordance with Article 46 of the Constitution of the Cook
Islands (as set out in Schedule 2 to the Cook Islands Constitution Amendment Act
1965) the Government of the Cook Islands has requested and consented to the
enactment of a provision extending all of the provisions of this Act to the Cook
Islands as part of the law of the Cook Islands: Be it therefore enacted as follows:
The provisions of this Act shall extend to the Cook Islands as part of the
law of the Cook Islands.
(2) Whereas in accordance with Article 36 of the Constitution of Niue (as
set out in Schedule 2 to the Niue Constitution Act 1974) the Niue Assembly has by
resolution requested and consented to the enactment of a provision extending all
of the provisions of this Act to Niue as part of the law of Niue: Be it therefore
enacted as follows:
The Niue Act 1966 is hereby amended by inserting, after section 684, the
following section:
“684A Citizenship Act in force in Niue
“The Citizenship Act 1977 shall extend to and be in force in Niue.”
(3) The provisions of this Act shall be in force in Tokelau.

30 Repeals, consequential amendments, and revocation

(1) The enactments specified in Schedule 2 to this Act are hereby
consequentially repealed.
(2) The enactments specified in Schedule 3 to this Act are hereby
consequentially amended in the manner indicated in that Schedule.
(3) The Citizenship Deprivation Rules 1949 are hereby consequentially
revoked.

Citizenship Act 1977 (NZ)

SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE 1

Oath of allegiance

281

Section 11

I, [Full name], swear that I will be faithful and bear true allegiance to Her [or His] Majesty [Specify the name of the reigning Sovereign, as thus: Queen Elizabeth the Second, Queen of New Zealand,] Her [or His] heirs and successors, according to law, and that I will faithfully observe the laws of New Zealand and fulfil my duties as a New Zealand citizen.

SCHEDULE 2

Enactments consequentially repealed

1948, No 15 – The British Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship Act 1948.

1948, No 28 – The Aliens Act 1948: Sections 3 to 13.

Section 30(1)

1959, No 38 – The British Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship Amendment Act 1959.

1965, No 71 – The Aliens Amendment Act 1965: So much of the Schedule as relates to sections

3 to 13 of the Aliens Act 1948.

1965, No 72 – The British Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship Amendment Act 1965.

1967, No 56 – The Aliens Amendment Act 1967.

1969, No 70 – The British Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship Amendment Act 1969.

1970, No 123 – The Western Samoa Amendment Act 1970.

1973, No 51 – The British Nationality and New Zealand Citizenship Amendment Act 1973.

SCHEDULE 3

Enactments consequentially amended

Enactment Amendment

Section 30(2)

1955, No 93 – By repealing section 16(2)(e), and substituting the following paragraph:

The Adoption Act “(e) Subject to the Citizenship Act 1977, the adoption order shall not affect the


282 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

SCHEDULE 4

Disclosure of information to specified agencies

Specified agency Purpose

Section 26A

Department of Internal Affairs To verify whether a person is eligible to hold a New Zealand passport

Registrar-General For the Registrar-General to he satisfied whether or not a

appointed under section 79 person is a New Zealand citizen

(1) of the Births, Deaths,

and Marriages Registration

Act 1995

Department of Inland Revenue To verify the identity of a person to establish—

(a) The tax file number of the person;

(b) The details of an applicant for child support

Department of Labour To verify—

(a) A person’s citizenship status;

(b) A person’s entitlement to reside in New Zealand

Department of Work To

and Income (a) verify a person’s eligibility or continuing eligibility for

benefits, war pensions, loans, or allowances

(b) verify a person’s eligibility or continuing eligibility for a

community services card

Ministry of Education To verify and update student information on the National Student

Index

283

CIVIL AVIATION ACT 1999

1999/250 – 15 August 1999

53-54 [Spent]

284 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

To regulate civil aviation and for related purposes

PART 1
PRELIMINARY

1 Short title

This is the Civil Aviation Act 1999.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“accident” means an occurrence that –
(a) Is associated with the operation of an aircraft; and
(b) Takes place between the time a person boards the aircraft with the
intention of flight and such time as each such person has
disembarked form the aircraft and its engine and any propeller or
rotor have come to rest,
being an occurrence –
(c) In which a person is fatally or seriously injured as a result of –
(i) being in the aircraft; or
(ii) direct contact with a part of the aircraft, including a part that
has become detached from the aircraft; or
(iii) direct exposure to jet blast,
except when the injury is self-inflicted or inflicted by another person,
or when the injury is to a stowaway hiding outside the areas normally
available to passengers and crew; or
(d) In which the aircraft sustains damage or structural failure that –
(i) adversely affects the structural strength, performance, or flight
characteristics of the aircraft; and
(ii) would normally require major repair or replacement of the
affected component,
except engine failure or damage that is limited to the engine, its cowling,
or an accessory, or damage that is limited to a propeller, a wing tip, a
rotor, an antenna, a tyre, a brake, a fairing, a small dent, or a puncture
hole in the aircraft’s skin; or
(e) In which the aircraft is missing or is completely inaccessible’
“Acting Director” means a person appointed under section 7;
“aeronautical product” means a thing that –
(a) comprises or is intended to comprise a part of an aircraft; or
(b) is or is intended to be installed in or fitted or supplied to an aircraft
including fuel and similar consumable items necessary for the
operation of an aircraft;
“aircraft” means a machine that can derive support in the atmosphere from
the reactions of the air otherwise than by the reactions of the air against
the surface of the earth;
“airport” means the Hanan International Airport and includes the buildings,
installations, and equipment on or adjacent to the airport used in
connection with the airport or its administration;
“aviation document” means a document issued under this Act to or in
respect of a person, aircraft, aerodrome, aeronautical procedure,
aeronautical product, or aviation related service;

Civil Aviation Act 1999

285
“aviation related service” means any – (a) equipment; or
(b) facility; or
(c) service,
operated in support of or in conjunction with the civil aviation system
and includes the provision of aeronautical products;
“Convention” means the Convention on International Civil Aviation signed
on behalf of the Government of Niue in Chicago on 7 December 1944
and includes –
(a) Any amendment to the Convention which has entered into force
under article 94 (a) of the Convention and has been ratified by or
on behalf of Niue; and
(b) Any Annex or amendment to the Convention accepted under article
90 of the Convention; and
(c) The international standards and recommended practices from time
to time accepted and amended by the ICAO under article 37 of the
Convention.
“Director” means the person appointed to be the Director of Civil Aviation
under section 5 but if –
(a) The Director is unable to perform the functions and duties of his
office; or
(b) The office of Director is vacant;
means the Acting Director;
“ICAO” means –
(a) The International Civil Aviation Organisation established under the
Convention; but
(b) If that Organisation ceases to exist, the successor to that
Organisation;
“incident” means an occurrence other than an aircraft accident that –
(a) Is associated with the operation of an aircraft; and
(b) Affects or could affect the safety of that operation;
“Minister” means the Minister to whom responsibility for civil aviation
has been assigned;
“navigation installation” means a building, facility, work, apparatus,
equipment or place (whether or not part of the airport) intended –
(a) To assist in the control of air traffic; or
(b) As an aid to air navigation,
and includes any land adjacent to and used in connection with any
such building, facility, work, apparatus, equipment, or place;
“Niue aircraft” means an aircraft registered in Niue under this Act;
“operate”, in relation to an aircraft, means –
(a) to fly or use the aircraft, or
(b) to cause or permit the aircraft to fly, be used, or be in a place, whether
or not the person is present with the aircraft, and “operator” has a
corresponding meaning;
“owner”, in relation to an aircraft, includes a person lawfully entitled to
the possession of the aircraft for a period of 28 days or longer;
“pilot-in-command”, in relation to an aircraft, means the pilot responsible
for the operation and safety of the aircraft;
“this Act” includes regulations made under this Act.
(2) In this Act a reference to the Civil Aviation Act 1990 of New Zealand
includes any Act of New Zealand that is to be read together with and deemed
part of the Civil Aviation Act 1990 of New Zealand.
286 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) If a penalty is set out at the foot of a section or subsection of this Act it means that a contravention of the section or subsection whether by act or omission is an offence punishable by a fine not exceeding the amount stated or by imprisonment not exceeding the period stated or both.

3 Act binds the Crown

This Act binds the Crown.
PART 2
APPOINTMENTS, DUTIES AND FUNCTIONS

4 Duty of the Minister

(1) It is the duty of the Minister –
(a) To promote safety in civil aviation; and
(b) To ensure that Niue’s obligations under international civil aviation
agreements are implemented.
(2) In particular, the Minister must –
(a) Administer Niue’s participation in the Convention and any other
international aviation convention, agreement, or understanding to
which Niue is a party; and
(b) Ensure that aviation security services are provided at the airport.

5 Appointment of Director

(1) There is established the office of the Director.
(2) The Niue Public Service Commission must appoint a suitably qualified
person to be the Director of Civil Aviation.
(3) The Cabinet may permit the Director to carry on his duties wile
permanently resident outside Niue.

6 Duty of the Director

(1) It is the duty of the Director to administer this Act.
(2) In particular, the Director must –
(a) Monitor adherence to safety and security standards within the civil
aviation system; and
(b) Ensure regular reviews of the civil aviation system to promote the
improvement and development of its safety and security; and
(c) Investigate and review civil aviation accidents and incidents; and
(d) Prepare and maintain an aviation security programme for Niue and
ensure its implementation; and
(e) Provide the Minister with any information and advice the Minister
requires.
(3) The Minister does not have the power to direct the Director on the
performance of his duties.

7 Acting Director

(1) There is established the office of Acting Director of Civil Aviation.
(2) The Niue Public Service Commission may appoint a suitably qualified
public officer to be the Acting Director to carry out the duties and perform the
functions of the Director if –
(a) The Director is unable to do so; or
(b) The office of Director is vacant.

Civil Aviation Act 1999

287

8 Safety and security inspections and monitoring

(1) The Director may in writing require a person who –
(a) Holds an aviation document; or
(b) Operates, maintains, or services, or does any other act in respect of
an aircraft, aeronautical product, aviation related service, air traffic
service, or aeronautical procedure,
to undergo or carry out inspections and monitoring the Director considers
necessary in the interests of civil aviation safety and security.
(2) The Director may in respect of a person described in subsection (1)(a)
or (b) carry out inspections and monitoring the Director considers necessary in
the interests of civil aviation safety and security.
(3) In order to inspect or monitor a person in accordance with subsection
(2) the Director may serve on the person a written notice requiring the person to
produce to the Director such information as the Director considers relevant to the
inspection or monitoring within any reasonable time specified in the notice.
(4) A person must comply with a requirement made under subsection (1)
or (3).
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units;
or
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.

9 Powers of Director

(1) If the Director is satisfied that –
(a) The operation of an aircraft or of a class or aircraft; or
(b) The use of an aeronautical product or a class of aeronautical
products;
may endanger a person or property, the Director may –
(i) detain the aircraft or aircraft of that class or
(ii) seize the aeronautical product or aeronautical products of that
class; or
(iii) prohibit or impose conditions on –
(A) The operation of the aircraft or aircraft of that class; or
(B) The use of an aeronautical product or aeronautical products
of that class.
(2) A detention or seizure under subsection (1) –
(a) Must not be maintained for longer than is necessary in the interest
of safety; but
(b) If the aircraft, aeronautical product, or a part of an aircraft or
aeronautical product is required as evidence in a prosecution – may
be maintained for as long as is necessary for that purpose.
(3) The Director must as soon as practicable provide a written reason for a
detention or seizure under this section.

10 Airworthiness directions

(1) The Director may issue an airworthiness directive in respect of –
(a) An aircraft; or
(b) Aeronautical product,
of a specified design if the Director is satisfied –
(i) that an unsafe condition exists in an aircraft or aeronautical
product of that design; and
(ii) that the condition is likely to exist in an or develop in any other
aircraft or aeronautical product of the same design.
288 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) An airworthiness directive comes into force on the date specified in it. (3) A person must comply with an airworthiness direction.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; (b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.

11 Exemption power of Director

(1) The Director may exempt a person, aircraft, aeronautical product, or
aviation related service from a requirement contained in regulations made under
this Act if –
(a) The Director considers it appropriate to do so; and
(b) It is not specifically provided by the regulations that exemptions
are not to be granted.
(2) Before granting an exemption the Director must satisfy himself –
(a) That –
(i) the requirement has been substantially complied with and that
further compliance is unnecessary; or
(ii) the action taken or provision made in respect of the matter to
which the requirement relates is as effective or more effective
than actual compliance with the requirement; or
(iii) the requirement is clearly unreasonable or inappropriate in the
particular case; or
(iv) an event has occurred that makes the requirement unnecessary
or inappropriate in the particular case; and
(b) That the risk to safety will not be significantly increased if the
exemption is granted.
(3) The Director may grant an exemption subject to compliance with any
condition the Director considers appropriate.

12 Director may suspend an aviation document

(1) The Director may –
(a) Suspend an aviation document; or
(b) Impose a condition in respect of an aviation document, if the
Director –
(c) Considers the action is necessary in the interests of safety; and
(d) Also –
(i) considers the action is necessary to ensure compliance with
this Act; or
(ii) is satisfied that the holder has failed to comply with a condition
of an aviation document or with a requirement of section 29;
or
(iii) is satisfied the holder has contravened or failed to comply with
section 47;
(iv) considers that the privileges or duties for which the document
has been granted are being carried out by the holder in a careless
or incompetent manner.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1) the Director may –
(a) Suspend an aviation document relating to the use of an aircraft,
aeronautical product, or the provision of a service; or
(b) Impose a condition in respect of an aviation document;
if the Director considers that there is a reasonable doubt as to –
(c) The airworthiness of the aircraft; or

Civil Aviation Act 1999

289
(d) The quality or safety of the aeronautical product or service, to which the document relates.
(3) The –
(a) Suspension of an aviation document; or
(b) Imposition of a condition in respect of an aviation document,
remains in force until the Director has determined, after due investigation, the
action to be taken in respect of the causes requiring the suspension or imposition
of the condition.
(4) Despite subsection (3) the –
(a) Duration of a suspension; or
(b) The period of imposition of a condition,
cannot exceed 14 days unless the Director directs that a further specified period is
necessary to complete the investigation.
(5) After an investigation the Director may –
(a) Suspend the aviation document for a further period; or
(b) Continue the imposition of the condition for a further period; or
(c) Revoke the aviation document.
(6) A person whose aviation document has been revoked, suspended, or
made subject to a condition must forthwith produce the document to the Director.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.
(7) The whole or part of an aviation document may be suspended.
(8) A person in respect of whom a decision is taken under this section may
appeal against that decision to the Minister.

13 Director may revoke or amend an aviation document

(1) The Director may if requested to do so by the holder of an aviation
document –
(a) Amend the document in the manner requested; or
(b) Revoke it.
(2) Subject to subsection (3), the Director may –
(a) Amend an aviation document to reflect the fact that the holder of
the document –
(i) is no longer carrying out a privilege or duty for which the
document was granted; or
(ii) is no longer able to carry out that privilege or duty; or
(b) Revoke an aviation document if the holder of the document –
(i) is no longer able to carry out each of the privileges or duties
for which the document was granted; or
(ii) is no longer able to carry out each of those privileges or duties;
or
(c) Amend an aviation document to correct a clerical error or obvious
mistake on the face of the document.
(3) The Director must notify the holder of the aviation document before
taking action under subsection (2) and give the holder a reasonable opportunity
to comment or make submissions on the proposed action.
(4) The power to amend an aviation document includes –
(a) The power to revoke the document and issue a new document in
its place; and
(b) The power to impose reasonable conditions.
290 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(5) If the Director notifies the holder of an aviation document that a specified action is proposed under this section the holder must forthwith produce the document to the Director.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; (b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.

14 Duties of pilot-in-command

The pilot-in-command of an aircraft –
(a) Is responsible for –
(i) the safe operation of the aircraft in flight; and
(ii) the safety and well-being of its passengers and crew; and
(iii) the safety of its cargo; and
(b) Has the final authority –
(i) to control the aircraft while in his command; and
(ii) for the maintenance of discipline by each person on board the
aircraft; and
(c) Subject to section 15, is responsible for compliance with each
requirement of this Act relating to the aircraft.

15 Duties during emergencies

(1) A pilot-in-command of an aircraft may in an emergency arising in flight
breach this Act if the pilot is satisfied that –
(a) The emergency involves a danger to life or property; and
(b) The extent of the breach of the provision does not go further than is
necessary to deal with the emergency; and
(c) There is no other reasonable means to alleviate, avoid, or assist with
the emergency; and
(d) The degree of danger in complying with the provision is clearly
greater than the degree of danger involved in deviating from the
provision.
(2) If an emergency (not being an emergency arising in flight) necessitates
the urgent transportation of a person or supplies for the protection of life or
property the pilot-in-command of the aircraft or its operator may breach this Act
if –
(a) The emergency involves a danger to life or property; and
(b) The extent of the breach of the provision does not go further than is
necessary to deal with the emergency; and
(c) There is no other reasonable means to alleviate, avoid, or assist with
the emergency; and
(d) The degree of danger involved in deviating from the provision is
clearly less than the degree of risk in failing to attend to the
emergency.
(3) Subsection (2) does not permit –
(a) The operation of an aircraft not registered in Niue or elsewhere; or
(b) The breach of this Act as to the airworthiness of an aircraft; or
(c) The operation of an aircraft by a person who is not lawfully entitled
to do so.

Civil Aviation Act 1999

291
(4) A pilot-in-command or an operator who breaches this Act under this section must –
(a) Immediately notify the relevant air traffic control service of the action; and
(b) As soon as practicable –
(i) notify the Director of the action and of the circumstances that
necessitated it; and
(ii) if requested to do so by the Director, within any time specified
by the Director provide the Director with a written report in
respect of the action.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.

16 Obligation to notify aircraft accidents and incidents

(1) The pilot-in-command of an aircraft involved in an aircraft accident
must notify the Director of the accident as soon as practicable.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.
(2) If a pilot-in-command of an aircraft is for any reason unable to give the
notification required by subsection (1) its operator must do so.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units;
or
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.
(3) A person –
(a) Who does an act in respect of an aircraft, aeronautical product, or
aviation related service; and
(b) Who when doing that act is involved in an aircraft incident, must
notify the Director of the incident if it is a serious incident under
the Convention.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.
(4) If the Director is given notification under this section the Director may
require the person who gave the information to provide additional information.
(5) A person must comply with a requirement made under subsection (4)
as soon as possible.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units;
or
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.

17 Aviation security

It is the duty of the police –
(a) To safeguard civil aviation operations against acts of unlawful
interference; and
(b) To protect people and property from dangers arising from the
commission or attempted commission of acts of unlawful
interference in respect of civil aviation operations.
292 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

18 Police to provide aviation security services

It is the duty of the police in respect of aviation security services at the
airport –
(a) To carry out passenger and baggage screening of aircraft passenger services and, if necessary, to undertake searches of passengers, baggage, cargo, aircraft, the airport and its navigation installations; and
(b) To carry out airport security patrols and patrols of the airport’s navigation installations; and
(c) To review, inquire into, and keep itself informed of security techniques, systems, devices, practices, and procedures related to the protection of civil aviation and people employed in or using civil aviation; and
(d) To undertake, or encourage or supervise, experimental or research work in aviation security; and
(e) To co-operate –
(i) with the authorities administering airport security services of
other countries; and
(ii) with appropriate international organisations.

19 Security areas

(1) The Director may declare by a sign or signs fixed at the perimeter of an
area within the airport that the area is a security area.
(2) Subject to subsection (3), a person other than –
(a) A constable; or
(b) A person authorised by the Director,
must not enter a security area.
(3) For the purpose of this section a person referred to in subsection (2)(b)
is not a person authorised by the Director to enter a security area unless –
(a) The person is wearing any identification device provided by the
Director identifying that person as a person authorised by the
Director to enter that security area; and
(b) The person is in the security area solely for the purpose of
performing the duties or carrying out the functions for which the
person was authorised by the Director to be in that security area.
(4) A person in a security area must if requested to do so by a constable –
(a) State to the constable –
(i) the person’s name and address; and
(ii) the person’s reason for being in the security area, and
(iii) the person’s authority (if any) to enter the area; and
(b) produce to the constable satisfactory evidence of the correctness of
that name and address.
(5) A person must not fail to comply with a request made under subsection
(4).
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.
(6) A constable may order a person to leave a security area if –
(a) The person fails or refuses to provide the constable with satisfactory
evidence of the person’s name and address if requested to do so by
the constable; or
(b) The person fails to satisfy the constable that the person is authorised
to be in that security area.

Civil Aviation Act 1999

293
(6).
(7) A person must not fail to comply with an order made under subsection
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.
(8) A constable may arrest without warrant a person who fails to comply
with a request made under subsection (4) or an order made under subsection (6).
(9) A constable, and any person whom the constable calls on for assistance,
may use such force as is reasonably necessary –
(a) To remove from a security area a person who fails or refuses to
leave the security area after having been ordered to do so under
subsection (6); or
(b) To arrest a person under subsection (8).
(10) A passenger embarking or disembarking directly through a gateway
or thoroughfare in the airport approved for that purpose by the Director is to be
taken to be authorised by the Director to pass through any security area forming
part of the gateway or thoroughfare.

20 General power of entry and arrest

(1) To implement this Act a constable or a person authorised for the purpose
by the Director may –
(a) Enter an aircraft, a building, or place; or
(b) Require the owner, occupier, or operator of an aircraft, aeronautical
product, or aviation related service –
(i) to produce a document the owner, occupier, or operator is
required to keep by virtue of this Act; and
(ii) to surrender the document; or
(c) If the constable or authorised person has reasonable grounds to
suspect that –
(i) a breach of this Act is being or is about to be committed; or
(ii) a situation exists within the civil aviation system or is about to
exist within that system that constitutes a danger to a person
or property, enter and inspect an aircraft, building, or place.
(2) An authorised person exercising the power of entry under subsection
(1) must produce the person’s authorisation from the Director if required to do so.

21 Powers of entry in respect of the airport

(1) A person authorised by the Director to do so may –
(a) Enter land to gain access to equipment used by the Government to
carry out the Government’s functions in respect of the airport; and
(b) Perform operations necessary to inspect, maintain, replace or repair
that equipment.
(2) A person who enters land in accordance with subsection (1) must
produce the person’s authorisation from the Director if required to do so by the
owner or occupier of the land.
PART 3
ENTRY INTO THE AVIATION SYSTEM

22 Requirement to register aircraft

(1) Except as otherwise provided in this Act, a person lawfully entitled to
the possession of an aircraft for a period of 28 days or longer which flies to, from,
within, or over Niue territory must register the aircraft and hold a valid certificate
of registration for it from –
294 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) The Director; or
(b) The appropriate aeronautical authority of a contracting State of
ICAO; or
(c) The appropriate aeronautical authority of another State that is party
to an agreement with Niue which provides for the acceptance of
each other ’s registrations.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
12 months or a fine not exceeding 1,000 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, fine not exceeding 100 penalty units.
(2) An aircraft cannot be registered in or remain registered in Niue if it is
registered in another country.
(3) The Director may decline to register an aircraft under regulations made
under this Act.
(4) A person in respect of whom a decision is taken under this section may
appeal against that decision to the Minister.

23 Regulations in respect of aviation documents

(1) Regulations or rules may require that aviation documents are required
by –
(a) People, aircraft, aeronautical products, aviation related services, facilities, and equipment operated in support of the civil aviation system; or
(b) Classes of people, aircraft, aeronautical products, aviation related services, facilities, and equipment operated in support of the civil aviation system,
as may, in the interests of safety or security, be specified in the regulations, and may, in particular, provide that aviation documents are required in respect of all or any of the following –
(c) Niue registered aircraft;
(d) Aircraft pilots;
(e) Flight crew members;
(f) Air traffic service personnel;
(g) Aviation security service personnel;
(h) Aircraft maintenance personnel;
(i) Air services;
(j) Air traffic services;
(k) Aviation security services;
(l) Aviation meteorological services;
(m) Aviation communications services.
(2) The regulations may prescribe the requirements, standards, and
application procedure for each aviation document, and the maximum period for
which each document may be issued.

24 Duration of aviation documents

Subject to the regulations, an aviation document may be issued by the
Director for such period and subject to such conditions as the Director considers
appropriate in each particular case.

25 Application for aviation document

(1) An application for the grant or renewal of an aviation document must
be made to the Director in the prescribed form or if there is no prescribed form in
such form as the Director may approve.

Civil Aviation Act 1999

295
(2) An applicant for an aviation document must include the applicant’s address for service in Niue including a telephone and facsimile number.
(3) The holder of an aviation document must promptly notify the Director of any change to the address, telephone number, or facsimile number of the holder. Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; (b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.
(4) The Director must record all information provided under this section
is a register maintained by the Director for the purpose.
(5) Service of a notification under this Act on a holder of, or applicant for,
an aviation document is effective service if served on the address last provided by
that holder or applicant under this section.

26 Grant or renewal of aviation document

(1) After considering an applicant for the grant or renewal of an aviation
document the Director must grant the application if the Director is satisfied that –
(a) All things in respect of which the document is sought meet the
relevant prescribed requirements; and
(b) The applicant and any person who is to have or is likely to have
control over the exercise of the privileges under the document –
(i) either has the relevant prescribed qualifications and experience
or has such foreign qualifications as are acceptable to the
Director under subsection (2); and
(ii) is a fit and proper person to have such control or hold the
document; and
(iii) meets all other relevant prescribed requirements; and
(c) It is not contrary to the interests of aviation safety for the document
to be granted or renewed.
(2) For the purpose of granting or renewing an aviation document the
Director may, subject to the regulations, accept such foreign qualifications or
recognise such foreign certifications as the Director considers appropriate in each
case.
(3) It is an implied condition of an aviation document that the holder and any person who has or is likely to have control over the exercise of the privileges under the document continue to satisfy the fit and proper person test specified in subsection (1)(b)(ii).
(4) If the Director declines to grant an application for the grant or renewal of an aviation document the applicant may appeal against that decision to the Minister.

27 Criteria for fit and proper person test

(1) For the purpose of determining whether a person is a fit and proper
person for the purpose of section 26(1)(b)(ii) the Director must, having regard to
the degree and nature of the person’s proposed involvement in the Niue civil
aviation system, have regard to, and give such weight as the Director considers
appropriate to –
(a) The person’s compliance history with transport safety regulatory
requirement; and
(b) The person’s related experience (if any) within the transport
industry; and
(c) The person’s knowledge of the applicable civil aviation system
regulatory requirements; and
296 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) Any history of physical or mental health or serious behavioural problems; and
(e) Any conviction for a transport safety offence whether or not – (i) the conviction was in a Niue court; or
(ii) the offence was committed before the commencement of this
Act; and
(f) Any evidence that the person has committed a transport safety
offence or has contravened or failed to comply with regulations
made under this Act.
(2) The Director is not confined to consideration of the matters specified
in subsection (1) but may take into account other matters and evidence the Director
considers relevant.
(3) To determine if a person is a fit and proper person the Director may –
(a) Seek and receive any information (including medical reports) the
Director considers relevant; and
(b) Consider information obtained from any source.
(4) In its application to a body corporate subsection (1) has effect as if –
(a) Paragraphs (a), (b), (c), (e) and (f) refer to the body corporate and
its officers; and
(b) Paragraph (d) refers only to the officers of the body corporate.

28 Applying for aviation document while disqualified

(1) A person must not apply for or obtain an aviation document while
disqualified by an order of a court from obtaining an aviation document.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.
(2) A document obtained contrary to subsection (1) is of no effect.

29 General requirements for participants in civil aviation system

(1) A person who does anything for which an aviation document is required
(in this section called an aviation participant) must ensure that the appropriate
aviation document and all the necessary qualifications and other documents are
held.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.
(2) An aviation participant must comply with this Act and the conditions
attached to the relevant aviation document.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.
(3) An aviation participant must ensure that the activities or functions for
which the aviation document has been granted are carried out –
(a) By the participant and by persons for whom the participant is
responsible; and
(b) Under the relevant prescribed safety standards and practices.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.
(4) An aviation participant who holds an aviation document that authorises
the provision of a service within the civil aviation system must –

Civil Aviation Act 1999

297
(a) If required to do so by regulations made under this Act, establish and follow a management system that will ensure compliance with the relevant prescribed safety standards and the conditions attached to the document; and
(b) Provide training and supervision to employees of the participant who are engaged in doing anything to which the document relates, so as to maintain compliance with the relevant prescribed safety standards and the conditions attached to the document and to promote safety; and
(c) Provide sufficient resources to ensure compliance with the relevant prescribed safety standards and the conditions attached to the document.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units; (b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.

30 Endangerment caused by holder of aviation document

(1) The holder of an aviation document must not, in respect of an activity
or service to which the document relates, do or omit to do an act or cause or
permit an act or omission, if the act or omission causes unnecessary danger to
another person or to property.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
12 months or a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 1,000 penalty
units.
(2) Subsection (1) is in addition to and not in derogation of any regulations
made under this Act.

31 Court may disqualify holder of aviation documents

(1) If a court convicts a person of an offence under section 29, section 47 or
section 48 it may in addition to any other penalty it imposes –
(a) Disqualify the person from holding or obtaining an aviation
document or a particular aviation document; or
(b) Impose on an aviation document held by or issued to the person
such restrictions or conditions or both as the court thinks fit having
regard to the circumstances of the offence;
for a period not exceeding 12 months.
(2) Subsection (1) does not affect or prevent the exercise by the Director of
his powers under section 26.
PART 4
AIR SERVICE OPERATIONS

32 Scheduled air service operations

A person must not engage in a scheduled air service operation between
Niue and elsewhere except –
(a) Under the authority of and in conformity with the terms and
conditions of an air service licence granted under this Act; or
(b) If stops are only made in Niue for non-traffic purposes.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.
298 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

33 Non-scheduled flights

(1) An aircraft of a state other than Niue that is not engaged in scheduled
international air service operation may –
(a) Make a non-scheduled flight in transit non-stop across Niue
territory; or
(b) Make a stop in Niue for a non-traffic purpose.
(2) The Director may require an aircraft referred to in subsection (1) –
(a) To land; or
(b) To obtain special permission for the flight.
(3) A person must not fail to comply with a requirement of the Director
imposed under subsection (2).
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.
(4) The pilot of an aircraft of a state other than Niue that is not engaged in
a scheduled international air service operation must not make a non-scheduled
flight across Niue territory with a stop in Niue for traffic purposes except –
(a) With the approval of the Director; and
(b) In compliance with any condition or limitation the Director imposes
on that approval.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.

34 Cabinet is licensing authority

(1) Cabinet may grant an air service licence.
(2) Cabinet may appoint a person to inquire into and report upon a matter
in relation to –
(a) An air service licence; or
(b) An application for an air service licence.

35 Application for an air service licence

(1) An application for an air service licence must –
(a) Be made to the Cabinet; and
(b) Be accompanied by such information and documents in support of
the application as Cabinet requires.
(2) Cabinet may –
(a) Refuse an application for an air service licence; or
(b) Grant it –
(i) in whole or in part; and
(ii) subject to any condition Cabinet considers necessary in the
public interest.
(3) An air service licence is to be in a form approved by Cabinet.

36 Duration of air service licence

(1) An air service licence –
(a) Takes effect on the date stated in it; and
(b) Unless sooner revoked or expressed to expire earlier expires 2 years
later.
(2) If –
(a) An application for the renewal of an air service licence has been
made; but

Civil Aviation Act 1999

299
(b) The application has not been disposed of before the date of expiry of the licence,
the licence continues in force until the application is disposed of unless Cabinet otherwise directs.

37 Terms of air service licence may be varied during currency

(1) Cabinet may if Cabinet considers it to be in the public interest to do
so –
(a) Amend or revoke a term or condition of an air service licence; or
(b) Add a new term or condition in an air service licence.
(2) Before exercising a power under subsection (1) Cabinet must give –
(a) The licensee; and
(b) Any other person Cabinet believes is likely to be affected,
at least 21 days notice of his intention to do so.

38 Renewal of air service licences

(1) An application for the renewal of an air service licence must –
(a) Be made to Cabinet; and
(b) Be accompanied by such information and documents in support of
the application as Cabinet requires.
(2) Cabinet may –
(a) Refuse an application for the renewal of an air service licence; or
(b) Grant it –
(i) in whole or in part; and
(ii) subject to any condition Cabinet considers necessary in the
public interest.
(3) The renewal of an air service licence –
(a) Unless sooner revoked or expressed to expire earlier expires 2 years
after it takes effect; and
(b) May be granted in advance to take effect on the expiry date of the
licence being renewed.

39 Inquiries as to air service licence

(1) Cabinet may appoint a person to hold a public inquiry to determine if
an air service operation being carried on under the authority of an air service
licence is being carried on in conformity with its terms and conditions.
(2) A person appointed under subsection (1) must give at least 21 days
notice of his intention to hold the inquiry to –
(a) The licensee; and
(b) Any other person he or she believes has an interest in the air service
licence.
(3) The notice must –
(a) State the day, time, and place fixed for the inquiry; and
(b) Contain details of the matter proposed to be inquired into.

40 Revocation of air service licences

Cabinet may revoke an air service licence or suspend it for any period the
Cabinet considers appropriate –
(a) If the air service operation authorised by the licence is not started
on the date specified in it for the start of the operation; or
(b) If the licensee abandons or curtails the air service operation
authorised by the licence; or
300 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) If after receiving the report of a person appointed to hold an inquiry Cabinet is satisfied that the licensee is not carrying on the air service operation in conformity with the licence; or
(d) If Cabinet is satisfied that the licensee has disposed of the air service operation authorised by the licence to another person without –
(i) transferring the licence to that person; or
(ii) obtaining Cabinet’s consent to the transfer.

41 Transfer of licence

(1) A licensee under an air service licence must not transfer the licence
without Cabinet’s written consent.
(2) An application for Cabinet’s consent to transfer an air service licence
must –
(a) Be made to Cabinet; and
(b) Be accompanied by such information and documents in support of
the application as Cabinet requires.
(3) Cabinet may –
(a) Refuse consent for the transfer of an air service licence; or
(b) Give it –
(i) in whole or in part; and
(ii) subject to any condition Cabinet considers necessary in the
public interest.

42 Licensee to provide information

It is an implied condition of an air service licence that the person authorised
to carry on an air service operation by virtue of the licence must provide the
Minister with any financial and statistical returns and statements the Minister
requires.

43 Nuisance, trespass, and responsibility for damage

(1) An action for nuisance cannot be brought in respect of the noise or
vibration caused by an aircraft or its engines while on, or taking off from, or landing
at, the airport.
(2) An action for trespass or nuisance cannot be brought in respect of the
flight of an aircraft over property at a height that is reasonable in the circumstances.
(3) If damage or loss is caused to property –
(a) By an aircraft while in flight, taking off or landing; or
(b) By a person or article in or falling from an aircraft;
damages are recoverable from the owner of the aircraft without proof of cause of
action as if the damage or loss was caused by the owner ’s fault unless the damage
or loss was caused by or contributed to by the fault of the person who suffered the
damage or loss.
(4) If –
(a) Damage or loss is caused in the manner described in subsection
(3); and
(b) Damages are recoverable from the owner of an aircraft solely by
virtue of subsection (3); and
(c) Another person is liable to pay damages in respect of the damage
or loss, the owner is entitled to be indemnified by that other person
against any claim in respect of the damage or loss.
(5) If damage or loss is caused by a person descending from an aircraft by
parachute –

Civil Aviation Act 1999

301
(a) Damages are not recoverable by virtue of subsection (4) from the owner of the aircraft; but
(b) Unless the damage or loss is caused by a person descending from an aircraft by parachute to avoid injury or death – damages are recoverable from the person descending and this section applies as if the person descending were the owner of the aircraft.
(6) If –
(a) An aircraft is hired by its owner to a person for a period of 28 days
or longer; and
(b) During that period no pilot, commander, navigator, or operative
member of the crew of the aircraft is an employee of the owner,
this section applies during the period as if each reference in it to the owner were a
reference to the person to whom the aircraft is hired.
(7) In this section “fault” means an act or omission which gives rise to a
liability in tort.
PART 5
OFFENCES

44 Dangerous activity involving aircraft, aeronautical product or aviation

related service

(1) A person must not –
(a) Operate, maintain, or service; or
(b) Do any other act,
in respect of an aircraft, aeronautical product, or aviation related service, in a
manner which causes unnecessary danger to a person or to property.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
12 months or a fine not exceeding 25 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 250 penalty
units.
(2) A person must not –
(a) Cause or permit an aircraft, aeronautical product, or aviation related
service to be operated, maintained, or serviced; or
(b) Cause or permit an act to be done in respect of an aircraft,
aeronautical product, or aviation related service,
in a manner which causes unnecessary danger to a person or property.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
12 months or a fine not exceeding 25 penalty units; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 250 penalty
units.

45 Operating aircraft in careless manner

A person must not operate an aircraft in a careless manner.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
12 months or a fine not exceeding 25 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 250 penalty
units.
302 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

46 Communicating false information affecting safety

A person must not provide to another person information relating to the
safety of –
(a) An aircraft; or
(b) The airport; or
(c) An aeronautical product; or
(d) An aviation related service; or
(e) Any other facility or product used in or connected with aviation; or
(f) A person associated with aviation,
knowing the information to be false or in a manner reckless as to whether it is
false.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.

47 Failing to disclose information relevant to aviation document

A person must not –
(a) Provide to the Director information relevant to the Director ’s
exercise of powers under this Act knowing it to be false; or
(b) Being an applicant for an aviation document, fail, without
reasonable excuse, to provide the Director information known to
the person which is relevant to the Director ’s exercise of a power
under this Act; or
(c) Being the holder of an aviation document, fail, without reasonable
excuse, to provide the Director information known to the person
which is relevant to the condition specified in section 26(3).
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
12 months or a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, fine not exceeding 300 penalty units.

48 Acting without necessary aviation document

A person must not –
(a) Operate, maintain, or service; or
(b) Do any other act in respect of,
an aircraft, aeronautical product, or aviation related service –
(c) Without holding the appropriate current aviation document; or
(d) Knowing –
(i) that a current aviation document is required to be held in respect
of that aircraft, product, or service before that act may lawfully
be done; and
(ii) that the appropriate aviation document is not held.
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
18 months or a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, fine not exceeding 1,000 penalty
units.

49 Obstruction of authorised person

(1) A person must not obstruct or impede a person who is authorised by
the Director to perform a duty or exercise a power while performing that duty or
exercising that power.

Civil Aviation Act 1999

303
Penalty: (a) In the case of an individual, imprisonment for a term not exceeding
3 months or a fine not exceeding 20 penalty units; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate, fine not exceeding 100 penalty units.
(2) Subsection (1) applies only if the person obstructed or impeded is in
uniform or produces evidence of his authority.

50 Trespass

A person must not, without reasonable excuse, enter or remain within the
airport or a building or area in which are operated technical facilities or services
for civil aviation if directed not to enter or remain –
(a) By a person authorised by the Director for that purpose; or
(b) By a constable; or
(c) By a notice or notices displayed for the purpose by the Director.
Penalty: Imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or a fine not exceeding
20 penalty units.
PART 6
REGULATIONS AND RULES

51 Power to make regulations

(1) The Cabinet may make regulations –
(a) To implement Niue’s obligations under the Convention; and
(b) In respect of any matter necessary or incidental to the
implementation of this Act.
(2) The Cabinet may, in particular, make regulations to prescribe fees and
charges payable generally for the purposes of civil aviation.
(3) The regulations may impose penalties for a breach of the regulations
not exceeding a fine of 50 penalty units or 6 months imprisonment, or both in the
case of an individual, or a fine not exceeding 250 penalty units in the case of a
body corporate.
(4) There may be incorporated by reference into regulations made under
this section all or any of the following –
(a) A standard, requirement, or recommended practice of an
international aviation organisation;
(b) A standard, requirement, or rule prescribed under law by another
contracting State of ICAO;
(c) A standard, requirement, or rule of an aviation sport or aviation
recreational organisation;
(d) Any other written material or document that in the opinion of the
Minister is too large or impractical to be printed as part of the
regulations.
(5) Material incorporated in regulations in accordance with subsection (4)
forms part of the regulations and unless otherwise provided in the regulations
any amendment to the material subsequently made by the person or organisation
that originated it also forms part of the regulations.
(6) A regulation is not invalid because –
(a) It confers a discretion upon or allows a matter to be determined or
approved by a person; or
(b) It allows a person to impose a requirement as to the performance
of an activity.
304

52

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

New Zealand Civil Aviation Rules to apply

(1) The New Zealand Civil Aviation Rules made under Part 3, Civil Aviation
Act 1990 of New Zealand shall extend to and be in force in Niue as from time to time amended and in force in New Zealand.
(2) An amendment made to the New Zealand Civil Aviation Rules shall not extend to and be in force in Niue if the Cabinet so resolves.
(3) Any provision of the New Zealand Civil Aviation Rules as extended to and in force in Niue by virtue of this Act shall cease to extend to and be in force if the Cabinet so resolves.

53-54 [Spent]

305

CIVIL LIST ACT 1999

1999/248 – 1 July 1999

8 Period for which Members’ remuneration and allowances are payable

9 Advance of remuneration

10 Advance of overseas travel allowance

11 Allowances to be treated as taxable income

12 [Spent]

SCHEDULE

To prescribe under article 25(2) of the Constitution the remuneration and other entitlements of the Premier, other Ministers, the Members of the Assembly who are not Ministers, and the Speaker

1 Short title

This is the Civil List Act 1999.

2 [Spent]

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Acting Premier” means a Minister discharging the functions of Premier
pursuant to article 9(1) or (2) of the Constitution;
“Member” means a person elected as a member of the Assembly under
article 16 of the Constitution but does not include the Premier, a Minister
or the Speaker;
“Minister” means a member of the Cabinet but does not include the Premier
or a temporary Minister;
“Premier” means a member of the Assembly elected under article 4 of the
Constitution but does not include an Acting Premier;
“Speaker” means the Speaker of the Niue Assembly elected under article
20 of the Constitution but does not include a member of the Assembly
performing the functions of the Speaker under that article;
“temporary Minister” means a Member appointed as a temporary Minister
under article 8 of the Constitution.
“Associate Minister” means a Member designed as an Associate Minister
for the purpose of assisting the Minister in the exercise of official duties.
306 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

4 Remuneration and allowances

There is payable to the Premier, Ministers, Members, and the Speaker the
remuneration and allowances specified in the Schedule.

5 Appropriation

A remuneration or allowance payable under this Act is to be paid out of
the Niue Government Account without further appropriation.

6 Payment of remuneration

A remuneration specified in Part 1 of the Schedule is payable by equal
fortnightly instalments in arrears with a proportionate payment for any fraction
of a fortnight served.

7 Period for which the Premier ’s and Ministers’ remuneration and allowances are payable

The remuneration and allowances of the Premier and each Minister of Cabinet shall commence on the day on which he/she is appointed under article 4 and 5 of the Niue Constitution and ending on the day that he/she vacates his/her office under article 3 or 7 of the Niue Constitution.

8 Period for which Members’ remuneration and allowances are payable

(1) The remuneration and allowance of each member shall commence on
the day the Chief Electoral Officer publicly declares him/her to be elected and
shall cease on the day a new Member has been declared by the Chief Electoral
Officer or unless his/her seat becomes vacant by death or otherwise as the case
may be.
(2) Where a member is returned unopposed his/her period of remuneration
shall recommence on the date that the Chief Electoral Officer declares him/her to
be elected and shall cease on the date a new Member has been declared by the
Chief Electoral Officer or unless his/her seat becomes vacant by death or otherwise
as the case may be.

9 Advance of remuneration

If a person who is entitled to be paid a remuneration under Part 1 of the
Schedule is due to be absent from Niue he or she may be paid that remuneration
in advance –
(a) If the person is due to be absent from Niue on official business
connected with his or her position in the Assembly, for such part of
the absence as the person is due to spend on that official business;
or
(b) In any other case, for the period of his or her absence from Niue up
to a maximum period of 4 weeks from his or her departure from
Niue.

10 Advance of overseas travel allowance

(1) An overseas travel allowance payable may be paid in advance of the
travel.
(2) If on the return of a person to whom an overseas travel allowance has
been paid in advance it is found that the allowance was paid in respect of too few days allowance in respect of the additional days is to be paid to the person.
(3) If on the return of a person to whom an overseas travel allowance has been paid in advance it is found that the allowance was paid in respect of too

Civil List Act 1999

307
many days the allowance paid in respect of the additional days is to be refunded by the person to whom it was paid within 7 days of his or her return to Niue under Part 2 of the Schedule.
(4) Any overseas travel allowance not repaid by a person under subsection
(3) may be deducted from any other money payable to that person under this Act.

11 Allowances to be treated as taxable income

An allowance referred to in Part 2 of the Schedule except for the Clothing
Allowance, Overseas Travel Allowance, Premier ’s Entertainment and Residence
Allowance, is to be treated as taxable income for income tax purposes.

12 [Spent]

SCHEDULE

PART 1 – REMUNERATION

Office Rate of Remuneration

Premier $60,803 a year

Minister $39,315 a year

Speaker $18,025 a year

Member $14,729 a year

PART 2 – ALLOWANCES

Type of allowance

Amount of allowance

Premier ’s entertainment allowance Payable to the Premier to cover costs incurred by the Premier in hosting official functions.

$1,323 a year

Premier ’s residence allowance Payable to the Premier to cover the cost of maintaining the Premier ’s residence

$6,000 a year

The Ministers

Payable to a minister annually

$3,000 a year

Acting Premier ’s allowance Payable to a Minister when acting as Premier

$60 a day in addition to remuneration as a Minister

Acting Minister ’s allowance Payable to a Member when acting as a Minister

$50 a day in addition to remuneration as Member

Clothing allowance

Premier $800 payable every 3 years Minister $750 payable every 3 years Speaker $500 payable every 3 years Member $500 payable every 3 years

308 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

The allowance is payable on the person first becoming a member of the Assembly and is then payable not sooner than 3 years after the payment of any previous

clothing allowance of any amount.

Overseas travel allowance

Payable to the Premier, a Minister,

a Member and the Speaker in

connection with the person’s

official duties

– To cover accommodation, meals

and incidental expenses necessarily

incurred in carrying out such duties.

Daily amount as determined by the Niue Public Service Commission The allowance may differ in respect of the office in the Assembly held

by the person travelling and by

the country or countries to be visited

by the person

The allowance payable is to be

reduced by an equal amount to

any allowance that is to be paid

by a person other than the

Government of Niue to cover

accommodation, meals and

incidental expenses.

Extra duties allowance

Payable to a Member who at the

request of a Minister and with

the approval of the Premier

provides assistance to that Minister

in the exercise of that Ministers

official duties.

$50 a day in addition to Associate

Minister remuneration as a Member

Select Committee Member ’s

Allowance

Payable to a Select Committee

Member who attends Select

Committee meetings

For meetings outside of normal working hours $70 per day

For meetings between

8.30am-12.30pm during normal

working hours $30 per day

For meetings during normal

working hours between 8.30am

and 4.00pm and beyond, $50 per

meeting

Speaker ’s Allowance

Payable to the Speaker to cover

costs incurred in relation to official

duties and representation at

functions

$1,000 a year

309

COMMISSIONS OF INQUIRY ACT 1968

1968/50 – 1 October 1968

1

Short title

8

Protection of witnesses and counsel

2

Interpretation

9

Witnesses’ allowances

3

Cabinet may appoint Commissions of

10 Payment of witnesses’ allowances

Inquiry

11 Non-attendance of witness

4

Members of Commissions protected

12 Reference of point of law to Court

5

Commissioners’ powers

13 Power to award costs

6

Persons interested entitled to be heard at

14 Enforcing orders for costs

inquiry

15 Powers of Judges when Commissioners

7

Service of summons

1 Short title

This is the Commissions of Inquiry Act 1968.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“ship” means every description of vessel used in navigation however
propelled.

3 Cabinet may appoint Commissions of Inquiry

(1) Cabinet may appoint any person or persons (including a member of
Cabinet) to be a Commission to inquire into and report upon any question arising
out of or concerning –
(a) The administration of the Government; or
(b) The working of any existing law; or
(c) The necessity of expedience of any legislation; or
(d) The conduct of any officer in the service of the Crown; or
(e) Any disaster or accident including any shipping casualty (whether
due to natural causes or otherwise) in which members of the public
were killed or injured or were or might have been exposed to risk
of death or injury.
(2) For the purpose of subsection (1) (e), a shipping casualty shall be deemed
to occur –
(a) When on or near the coast of Niue any ship is lost, abandoned, stranded or materially damaged or has been in collision with any ship; or
(b) When any loss of life ensues by reason of any casualty occurring to
any ship on or near the coast of Niue; or
(c) When in any place any such loss, abandonment, stranding, material
damage, or casualty as aforesaid occurs, and any witness is found
in Niue; or
310 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) When in any place any such loss, abandonment, stranding, material damage, or casualty as aforesaid occurs or is supposed to have occurred to any ship registered in Niue under the provisions of any law made in that behalf and for the time being in force; or
(e) When any ship proceeds to sea from any harbour in Niue and is lost or is supposed to have been lost and any evidence is obtainable in Niue as to the circumstances under which she proceeded to sea or was last heard of.

4 Members of Commissions protected

So long as any member of any such Commission acts bona fide in the
discharge of his duties, no action shall lie against him for anything he may report
or say in the course of the inquiry.

5 Commissioners’ powers

Every such Commission shall for the purpose of the inquiry have the power
and status of a Judge of the Court in respect of citing parties interested in the
inquiry, summoning witnesses, administering oaths, hearing evidence, and
conducting and maintaining order at the inquiry.

6 Persons interested entitled to be heard at inquiry

Any person interested in the inquiry shall, if he satisfies the Commission
that he has an interest in the inquiry apart from any interest in common with the
public, be entitled to appear and be heard at the inquiry as if he had been cited as
a party to the inquiry.

7 Service of summons

Every summons to a witness shall be served either by delivering the same
to the person summoned or by leaving the same at his usual place of abode within
a reasonable time before his attendance is required.

8 Protection of witnesses and counsel

Every witness attending and giving evidence in pursuance of any such
summons, and every counsel appearing before any Commission, shall have the
same privileges and immunities as witnesses and counsel in the Court.

9 Witnesses’ allowances

(1) Every witness attending in pursuance of any such summons shall be
entitled to expenses for travelling and maintenance during his absence from his
usual place of abode under the scale allowed to witnesses in civil cases by the
rules of the Court.
(2) Persons prosecuting any claim before a Commission shall not be entitled
to be paid any money under this section.

10 Payment of witnesses’ allowances

(1) Where the Commission has obtained the authority in writing of the
Resident Commissioner for summoning any witness, the expenses of that witness
shall, if certified by the Chairman of the Commission be paid by the Treasurer out
of the Niue Government Account.
(2) In every other case the person requiring the evidence of any witness
shall, before the summons is issued, deposit with the Commission such sum of
money as the Commission deems sufficient, and the expenses of the witness shall
be paid out of the sum so deposited.

Commissions of Inquiry Act 1968

311

11 Non-attendance of witness

(1) Every person who, after being duly summoned to attend before the
Commission, or to produce to it any books, papers, writings or documents –
(a) Fails to appear under the exigency of such summons; or
(b) Refuses to be sworn or to give evidence, or to make answer to such
questions as may be put to him by the Commission or any member
thereof touching the subject of the inquiry; or
(c) Fails to produce any such books, papers, writings, or documents;
is liable for every such default to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
(2) No person so summoned shall be liable to any such fine unless at the
time of the service of the summons there was made to him a payment or a tender
of his travelling expenses, according to the scale allowed to witnesses in civil cases
by the rules of the Court.

12 Reference of point of law to Court

(1) Subject to section 15 the Commission may refer any disputed point of
law arising in the course of an inquiry to the Court for decision, and for this purpose
may either conclude the inquiry subject to such decision or may at any stage of
the inquiry adjourn it until after the decision has been given.
(2) The question shall be in the form of a special case to be drawn up by
the parties (if any) to the inquiry, and, if the parties do not agree or if there are no
parties, to be settled by the Commission.
(3) The decision of the Court shall be final and binding upon all parties to
the inquiry and upon the Commission.

13 Power to award costs

(1) The Commission, upon the hearing of an inquiry, may order that the
whole or any portion of the costs of the inquiry or of any party thereto shall be
paid by any of the parties to the inquiry, or by all or any of the persons who have
procured the inquiry to be held.
(2) No such order shall be made against any person who has not been
cited as a party or authorised by the Commission, pursuant to section 6 to appear
and be heard at the inquiry or summoned to attend and give evidence at the inquiry.

14 Enforcing orders for costs

For the purpose of enforcing any order of the Commission for the payment
of costs, a duplicate of such order may be filed by the person to whom the costs
are payable in any office of the Court and shall thereupon be enforceable in all
respects as a final judgment of that Court in its civil jurisdiction.

15 Powers of Judges when Commissioners

(1) In every case where under this Act, or any other enactment Cabinet
appoints one or more Judges of the Court to be members of a Commission for the
purpose of holding an inquiry, every such Judge, and the Commission of which
he is a member, shall for all the purposes of such inquiry, have the same powers,
privileges and immunities as are possessed by a Judge of the High Court in the
exercise of its civil jurisdiction.
(2) For the purpose of enforcing any order made by such Commission the
order shall, as soon as conveniently may be after the making thereof, be drawn up
and signed by the Chairman (whose signatures and status shall be judicially
noticed), and may be filed in any office of the Court, whereupon the order shall be
enforceable in the same manner as a final judgment of the Court in civil
proceedings.

312 Niue Laws 2006 Voll

313

COMMUNICATIONS ACT 1989

1989/131 – June 1989

19 Obligation

PART 2

POSTAL SERVICES

20 Interpretation

21 Control on carriage of postal articles

22 Control on creation of postage stamps

23 Stealing postal articles

24 Delay and interference with postal articles

25 Divulging contents of postal articles

26 Prohibited material

27 Penalties

28 Lawful opening of postal articles

29 Insufficient postage

30 Regulations

PART 3

ELECTRONIC ADDRESSING

30A Interpretation

30B Objectives and obligations

30C Niue Information Technology Committee

30D Appointed Manager/s of electronic

addressing

30E Cabinet may give directions to the

Appointed Manager of electronic

addressing

30F Delegation of powers

31-32 [Spent]

PART 4

REPEAL AND SAVINGS

To make provisions in respect of communications within Niue and between Niue and elsewhere

1 Short title

This is the Communications Act 1989.
PART 1
TELECOMMUNICATIONS

2 Objectives and obligations

(1) In the administration of this Part the Cabinet and the Director shall
have regard to the objectives of –
314

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

(a) Facilitating the development of communications both within Niue and between Niue and elsewhere;
(b) Providing within Niue public communications services of a kind and quality appropriate to the social, cultural, educational and economic needs of Niue;
(c) Ensuring that effective means exist to control and supervise the
programmes transmitted by any public communications service
within Niue so that they benefit the Niuean community; and
(d) Providing the people of Niue with a reliable and efficient telephone
service at a reasonable cost.
(2) In the administration of this Part the Cabinet and the Director shall, so
far as practicable, act in accordance with any applicable standards, rules and
regulations set by international agreements binding upon Niue.

3 Interpretation

In this Part –
“Cabinet” includes any person authorised by the Cabinet to exercise a power
of the Cabinet under this Part;
“Director” means the person for the time being carrying out the duties of
the head of the Telecommunications Department of the Government;
“operate”, in respect of any transmission or reception installation, does
not include the operation of an ordinary telephone handset;
“radiocommunications transmitter” means a transmission installation
designed to transmit electromagnetic energy without continuous
artificial guide;
“radiocommunications receiver” means a reception installation designed
to receive electromagnetic energy without continuous artificial guide;
“reception”, in respect of a reception installation, includes interception;
“reception installation” –
(a) Means an apparatus designed to receive by means of electric or
electromagnetic energy either with or without –
(i) sounds (including speech and music);
(ii) visual images;
(iii) any other signals for the purpose of communications, or for
the actuation or control of machinery or apparatus; but
(b) does not include an installation designed solely to receive signals
intended for direct reception by the general public;
“transmission installation” –
(a) Means an apparatus designed to transmit, by means of electric or
electromagnetic, either with or without artificial guide –
(i) sounds (including speech and music);
(ii) visual images;
(iii) any other signals for the purpose of communications, or for
the actuation or control of machinery or apparatus; but
(i) does not include an installation which –
(I) is not a radiocommunication transmitter;
(II) is confined within a single property boundary; and
(III) is not connected to the Niue telephone system; or
(ii) an aerial and lines which are not used except to receive a signal
intended for direct reception by the general public and to
distribute that signal free of charge without alteration.

Communications Act 1989

315

4 Control of transmission installations

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a person shall not operate a transmission
installation unless authorised to do so by the licence granted under this Part.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to –
(a) A person acting on behalf of the Government in accordance with
general or specific authorisation given by the Cabinet or by a person
authorised by the Cabinet to give that authorisation;
(b) A member of the crew of a foreign registered vessel or aircraft
operating a transmission installation on board the vessel or aircraft
under any directions of the Director; or
(c) A person operating a transmission installation in circumstances
where that person reasonably believes it necessary to do so because
an emergency exists.
(3) A person who operates a transmission installation contrary to the
provisions of this Part or contrary to the provisions of any licence granted under
this Part is guilty of an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2
penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months, or to both
such fine and imprisonment.

5 Control of reception installations

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a person shall not operate a reception
installation with intent to receive signals (other than signals intended for direct
reception by the general public) emanating from outside Niue unless authorised
to do so by a licence granted under this Part.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply in relation to a person acting on behalf of
the Government under a general or specific authorisation given by the Cabinet or
by a person authorised by the Cabinet to give that authorisation.
(3) A person who operates a reception installation contrary to this Part or
contrary to the provisions of any licence granted under this Part is guilty of an
offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit or to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months, or to both such fine and
imprisonment.

6 Public communications service licence

(1) A public communications service licence authorises the licensee to
operate a service the primary purpose of which is the transmission of sound or
visual images, or both, for direct reception by the general public.
(2) Where –
(a) A member of the general public is not entitled to receive sound or a
visual image except upon payment of a fee to a licensee; or
(b) Sound or a visual image is transmitted in an encoded form,
that fact shall not, by itself, be taken to indicate that the sound or visual image was
not intended for direct reception by the general public.

7 Private communications service licence

A private communications service licence authorises the licensee to operate
a service, the primary purpose of which is the transmission of sound or visual
images, or both, and the direct reception of those sound or visual images, or both,
by persons within a specified group of persons (other than the general public).
316 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

8 Radiocommunications licence

A radiocommunications licence authorises a person to operate one or more
of the following, namely –
(a) A radiocommunications transmitter;
(b) A radiocommunications receiver;
(c) A radiocommunications transceiver.

9 Grant of public communications service licences

(1) The Cabinet may grant public communications service licences.
(2) The Cabinet may grant a licence under subsection (1) for any period
not exceeding 5 years and may renew such a licence for further periods each not
exceeding 5 years.
(3) A licence granted under subsection (1) is subject to such conditions as
are specified in it.
(4) The Cabinet may revoke, or vary any condition specified in a licence
granted under subsection (1) and may make such a licence subject to additional
conditions.
(5) The Cabinet may refuse to renew a licence granted under subsection
(1) or may revoke such a licence if, in its opinion, the licensee –
(a) Has failed to comply with any condition of the licence or with any
law relating to the operation of the transmission installation; or
(b) Is no longer a suitable person to hold the licence or no longer has
the financial, technical or management capability to provide a
service appropriate to the general public of Niue.
(6) The Cabinet may either generally or in any particular case authorise
another person to exercise all or any of its powers under this section.

10 Grant of private communications service licences and radiocommuni­

cations licence

(1) The Director may grant –
(a) Private communications service licences; and
(b) Radiocommunication licences.
(2) The Director may refuse to grant a licence under subsection (1) if, in his
opinion –
(a) The applicant has insufficient training to operate the relevant transmission or reception installation; or
(b) In the case of a private communications service licence, any person within the specified group of persons referred to in section 7 has insufficient training to operate the relevant transmission or reception installation.
(3) The Director may grant a licence under subsection (1) for a period of 1
year and may renew such a licence for further periods of 1 year.
(4) A licence granted under subsection (1) is subject to such conditions as
are specified in it.
(5) The Director may revoke or vary any condition specified in a licence
granted under subsection (1) and may make such a licence subject to additional
conditions.
(6) The Director may refuse to renew a licence granted under subsection
(1) or may, at any time, revoke such a licence if, in his opinion, the licensee has
failed to comply with any condition of the licence or with any provision of this or
any other law relating to the operation of the transmission or reception installation.

Communications Act 1989

317
(7) The Cabinet may, within 28 days of the Director taking any action under this section, review that action.
(8) Where the Cabinet, after reviewing any action of the Director, decides that no action or different action should have been taken, the decision shall have effect and the action of the Director shall cease to have effect.

11 Schedule of transmission and reception installations

(1) Before a public or private communications service licence is issued, the
Director shall prepare a schedule for the licence setting out the specifications of all
the transmission or reception installations to be used to provide the service
authorised by the licence.
(2) A public or private communications service licence authorises the
licensee to operate transmission or reception installations complying with the
specifications set out in the schedule to the licence for the purpose of the service
authorised by the licence but for no other purpose.
(3) The Director may, after giving the licensee reasonable notice of his
intention to do so, vary a schedule to a public or private communications service
licence.

12 Programmes of public communications service

(1) The licensee under a public communications service licence –
(a) Shall not transmit any advertisement unless authorised to do so in
writing by the Cabinet; and
(b) Shall comply with any programme guidelines issued by the
Programme Advisory Committee established under section 13.
(2) For the purpose of subsection (1) “advertisement” does not include –
(a) A community announcement; or
(b) Programme promotion,
transmitted without charge.

13 Programme Advisory Committee

(1) There is established by this Act a Programme Advisory Committee
consisting of not less than 3 members nor more than 6 members appointed by the
Cabinet.
(2) The Programme Advisory Committee shall –
(a) Advise licensees under public communications services licences on
all aspects of the services authorised by their licences, including
the nature and diversity of their programmes, the suitability of
programmes for Niue, the hours of transmission of the services,
and the amount of any fee which may be charged for the reception
of the services; and
(b) In consultation with licensees under public communications service
licences, prepare and subsequently publish a set of programme
guidelines for public communication services.
(3) Programme guidelines may, in addition to other matters, include
guidelines in respect of –
(a) Material offensive to community standards of behaviour in Niue;
(b) The depiction of sexual activities, violence and the use of drugs;
(c) The amount of times to be assigned for educational, informational
and religious programmes; and
(d) The classification of programmes as suitable for transmission at
various times of the day.
318 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(4) For the purposes of subsection (3) (a) and (b), the Programme Advisory Committee may in consultation with the Censor of Films appointed under the Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979, apply the same guidelines as those applied by the Censor of Films.
(5) Where the Cabinet has authorised the transmission of advertisements, programme guidelines may also include guidelines in respect of –
(a) The content of advertisements;
(b) The products which may or may not be advertised; and
(c) The amount of transmission time allocated to the transmission of
advertisements.

14 Power of Cabinet to require certain transmissions

(1) When required to do so by the Cabinet, the licensee under a public
communications service licence shall make the service available to transmit any
programme or other matter the Cabinet considers to be in the national interest.
(2) A licensee shall not be obliged to make his service available under
subsection (1) for more than 3 hours in any period of 24 hours.
(3) During any period of national emergency proclaimed under section 2
of the Public Emergency Act 1979 –
(a) The limitation referred to in subsection (2) shall not apply; and
(b) The licensee under any public or private communications service
licence or radiocommunications licence shall make the service or
his radiocommunications transmitter, as the case may be, available
to authorised officers of the Government to transmit such matter
as the Cabinet considers necessary.
(4) The power of the Cabinet under subsection (1) does not include power
to require a licensee to transmit any programme or other matter that could
reasonably be interpreted as promoting or opposing –
(a) The election of a candidate as a member of the Assembly; or
(b) A particular point of view in relation to an issue or matter that is
being submitted to the electorate in an election of members of the
Assembly.

15 Forfeiture

(1) Where a person is convicted of an offence under this Part the court
may order that any transmission or reception installation used in connection with
that offence be forfeited to the Government.
(2) Any transmission or reception installation forfeited to the Government
under subsection (1) becomes the property of the Government which may retain
the installation or dispose of it in such manner as it thinks fit.

16 Director may give directions

(1) Subject to compliance with any direction given to him by the Cabinet,
the Director may give a person directions in respect of all or any of the following,
namely –
(a) The technical standards and requirements of any transmission or reception installation;
(b) The frequencies, power and location of any radiocommunication equipment;
(c) The location of any line, pole or associated equipment used in
connection with the provisions of a public or private
communications service, and situated outside land owned or
occupied by the licensee.

Communications Act 1989

319
(2) A person who fails to comply with a direction given to him under subsection (1) is guilty of an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

17 Exemptions

(1) Subject to subsection (2), the Director may exempt a reception or
transmission installation or reception or transmission installation within a specified
class of reception or transmission installation from all or any of the provisions of
this Part.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to or in respect of any transmission
installation used for or in connection with the transmission of sound or visual
images, or both, intended for direct reception by the general public.

18 Regulations (Part 1)

The Cabinet may make regulations for carrying out this Part and without
in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing such regulation may provide
for –
(a) The charges which may be levied for services provided by the
Government;
(b) The fees which may be charged for the grant or renewal of a licence
under this Part;
(c) Periodic fees which may be payable in respect of a licence under
this Part;
(d) The prevention of harmful interference with any transmission
installation or any signals transmitted to, from, or within Niue;
(e) The conditions upon which persons may subscribe to the Niue
telephone system;
(f) The conditions upon which any private communication service may
be connected to the Niue telephone system; and
(g) Penalties, not exceeding 1 penalty unit for any breach of the
regulations.

19 Obligation

PART 2
POSTAL SERVICES
In the administration of this Part the Cabinet, the Niue Post Office and the Postmaster shall, so far as practicable, act under any applicable standards, rules and regulations set by international agreements binding upon Niue.

20 Interpretation

In this Part –
“Niue Post Office” means that Department of Government established to
conduct postal services both within Niue and between Niue and
elsewhere and includes –
(a) The officers and employees of that Department;
(b) Any person authorised by the Postmaster to collect or deliver postal
articles for fee or commission on behalf of the Niue Post Office; and
(c) Any casual or contract staff of the Niue Post Office;
“postal article” means any article transmissible by post, including a letter,
postcard, packet or package, or a telegram which is to be conveyed or
otherwise dealt with in the manner of a posted letter;
“Postmaster” means the person for the time being carrying out the duties
of the office in the public service having the designation Postmaster.
320 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

21 Control on carriage of postal articles

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a person commits an offence if he carries or
conveys or causes to be carried or conveyed a postal article for reward.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply –
(a) To the Niue Post Office; or
(b) To a person acting under an agreement with the Niue Government
or the Niue Post Office for the carriage of postal articles within Niue
or between Niue or elsewhere.

22 Control of creation of postage stamps

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a person is guilty of an offence if he creates a
Niue postage stamp.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply in relation to –
(a) The Niue Post Office; or
(b) A person acting with and under the authorisation of the Cabinet.

23 Stealing postal articles

A person is guilty of an offence if he steals a postal article in the possession
of the Niue Post Office.

24 Delay and interference with postal articles

(1) A person is guilty of an offence if he unlawfully opens a postal article
in the possession of the Niue Post Office.
(2) An officer, employee or person acting on behalf of the Niue Post Office
is guilty of an offence if, contrary to his duty, he –
(a) Opens or procures or suffers to be opened a postal article in the
possession of the Niue Post Office; or
(b) Wilfully delays or detains a postal article in the possession of the
Niue Post office or procures or suffers such a postal article to be
delayed or detained.
(3) A person who receives from the Niue Post Office a postal article not
intended for him is guilty of an offence if he wilfully opens, keeps, detains or
destroys the postal article.

25 Divulging contents of postal articles

(1) Subject to subsection (2), an officer, employee or person acting on behalf
of the Niue Post Office is guilty of an offence if he divulges to another person
information from, or as to the contents of, a postal article that is or was in the
possession of the Niue Post Office and that came to his knowledge in the course of
his duty.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of information an officer,
employee or person is lawfully entitled or obliged to divulge.

26 Prohibited material

(1) A person is guilty of an offence if he posts a postal article knowing it to
contain a prohibited material.
(2) For the purpose of subsection (1) “prohibited material” means –
(a) Explosive, dangerous or destructive substances or fluids;
(b) Noxious animals and other things;
(c) Indecent or obscene writings, pictures or articles;
(d) Sharp articles, fluids or other injurious thing when not properly
packed.

Communications Act 1989

321

27 Penalties

A person convicted of an offence under this Part is liable on conviction –
(a) In the case of an offence under section 22 to a fine not exceeding 10
penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 12 months
or to both such fine and imprisonment;
(b) In the case of an offence under sections 21, 23, 24 of 25 to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 6 months or to both such fine and imprisonment; and
(c) In the case of an offence under section 26 to a fine not exceeding 2
penalty units.

28 Lawful opening of postal articles

(1) The Postmaster may, when authorised to do so by the Cabinet, detain
and open a postal article in the possession of the Niue Post Office which he
reasonably believes to contain prohibited material as defined in section 26 (2).
(2) The Postmaster shall not open a postal article under subsection (1) unless
he has given the sender and intended recipient of the article notice of his intention
to open the article and a reasonable opportunity to be present when he does so.
(3) Subsection (2) does not apply in relation to as sender or intended
recipient of a postal article who is not in Niue.
(4) If a postal article opened under this section is found to contain
prohibited material the Postmaster may destroy the article or direct that it be
forfeited to the Government, or direct that the article be returned to its sender.
(5) A person is not entitled to compensation in respect of any damage
suffered by him as the result of the opening of a postal article under this section.

29 Insufficient postage

(1) The Niue Post Office may refuse to carry a postal article in respect of
which insufficient postage has been paid.
(2) The Niue Post Office may refuse to deliver a postal article in respect of
which insufficient postage has been paid except upon payment of any prescribed
surcharge.

30 Regulations

(1) The Cabinet may make regulations for carrying out this Part and
without in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing such regulations may
provide –
(a) For the prescription of fees for the carriage of postal articles; and
(b) Penalties, not exceeding 1 penalty unit, for any breach of the
regulations.
(2) Regulations made for the purposes specified in subsection (1) may be
made by reference to regulations either as in force on a specified date or as in force
in New Zealand and either with or without amendments of those regulations.

30A Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 3
ELECTRONIC ADDRESSING
“NITC” means the Niue Information Technology Committee; “ccTLD” means country code Top Level Domain;
“.nu” means the ccTLD two letter code designated and applying to Niue;
322 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
“electronic addressing” means the use of any scheme for organising, distributing or assigning any type of symbolic reference, name, address, code which is pertinent to the transfer of information within and between information systems. Including but not exclusive to internet addressing schemes including those referred to by the ISO 3166;
“ISO 3166” means Standard 3166 of the International Organisation for
Standardisation.

30B Objectives and obligations

(1) In the administration of this Part, Cabinet shall have regard to the
objectives of –
(a) Facilitating the development of Information Technology and
electronic addressing both within Niue, between Niue and
elsewhere;
(b) The recognition that the ccTLD .nu is a National resource for which
the prime authority is the Government of Niue;
(c) Ensuring that effective means exist to control and supervise the
information transmitted or made available by any appointed
Manager of the Niue ccTLD.nu;
(d) Ensure that the ccTLD .nu is managed consistent with the interests
and matters of public importance of the Niuean community and
consistent with the public policy objectives of the Government.
(2) In the administration of this Part the Cabinet shall, so far as practicable,
act under any applicable standards, rules and regulations set by international
agreements binding upon Niue.

30C Niue Information Technology Committee

(1) There is established by this Act the NITC consisting of not less than 3
members nor more than 6 members appointed by the Cabinet.
(2) The NITC shall be the only designated Registry Manager of the Niue
ccTLD .nu.
(3) The NITC shall –
(a) Advise Cabinet on all matters related to and associated with
Information Technology and the management of the ccTLD .nu;
(b) Be responsible for establishing and monitoring any and all
contractual relationships entered into relating to the management
of the ccTLD .nu;
(c) When and where appropriate appoint technical and administrative
advisors.

30D Appointed Manager/s of electronic addressing

(1) Cabinet on the advice of the NITC determine for the purposes of this
Part, a specified person or association as an appointed manager of electronic
addressing in relation to a specified kind of listed carriage services utilizing the
ccTLD .nu.
(2) The appointment has effect accordingly.
(3) Cabinet must not make a re-appointment under subsection (1) in
relation to a particular person or association unless –
(a) The NITC recommends Cabinet to do so;
(b) The NITC is of the opinion that the person or association is
managing electronic addressing in accordance with the interests,
principles and standards of the Niuean community and the public
policy of the Government.

Communications Act 1989

323
(4) The Cabinet may give written directions to the NITC in relation to its advisory role.

30E Cabinet may give directions to the Appointed Manager of electronic addressing

(1) The Cabinet may, by written notice given to an Appointed Manager of electronic addressing in relation to a particular kind of carriage service, directing manager to do, or refrain from doing, a specified act or thing relating to electronic addressing in connection with that kind of carriage service utilising the ccTLD
.nu.
(2) The Cabinet may not give a direction under this section unless, in the opinion of the Cabinet, the issues pertaining to the electronic addressing is of public importance to the Niuean community.
(3) In determining whether the electronic addressing is of public importance the Cabinet must have regard to the extent to which the addressing is of significant social and/or economic importance to –
(a) Service providers; and
(b) End-users of carriage services.
(4) Subsection (3) does not, by implication, limit the matters to which
Cabinet may have regard.
(5) Before giving a direction under this section, the Cabinet must consult
the NITC.
(6) A person must comply with a direction under this section.
(7) A person or association who intentionally or recklessly contravenes
subsection (6) is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction by a fine not
exceeding US 5,000,000.

30F Delegation of powers

Cabinet may delegate all or part of its powers vested under this Act to the
NITC.

21-22 [Spent]

PART 4
REPEAL AND SAVINGS

324 Niue Laws 2006 Vall

325

COMPANIES ACT 2006

1 Short title

PART 1

Issue of shares

25 Issue of initial shares

26 Issue of other shares

27 Time of issue of shares

2 [Spent]

PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

Distributions – general

3 Interpretation

4 Overview

5 Act binds the Government

28 Distributions prohibited unless solvency test satisfied

29 Recovery of improper distributions

PART 2

INCORPORATING NEW COMPANIES

Subpart 1 – Incorporation

30 Dividends

Dividends

6 Application for incorporation

7 Certificate of incorporation

8 Effect of incorporation

9 Registration as private company or

public company

Subpart 2 – Names

10 Name of company

11 Change of name

12 Direction to change name

13 Use of company name

Subpart 3 – Company rules

14 Adoption and alteration of rules

15 Model rules

16 Contents and effect of rules

Subpart 4 – Registered office and postal address

17 Registered office and postal address

18 Change of registered office and postal

address

19 Requirement to change registered office

or postal address

PART 3 SHARES General

20 Legal nature of shares

21 No nominal value

22 Minimum number of shares

24 Shares must not impose liabilities on

holder

Acquisition of own shares

31 Company may acquire its own shares

32 Cancellation of shares acquired by

company

33 Enforcement of contract to repurchase

shares

Redeemable shares

34 Redeemable shares

35 Redemption of redeemable shares

Assistance by company in purchase of its own shares

36 Financial assistance

Cross-holdings

37 Cross-holdings

Transfer of shares

38 Transfer of shares

39 Transfer of shares by operation of law

Share register

40 Company to maintain share register

41 Share register as evidence of legal title

42 Power of Court to rectify share register

43 Trusts not to be entered on register

44 Registration of personal representative

or assignee of bankrupt

326 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Share certificates

45 Share certificates

PART 4

SHAREHOLDERS

Subpart 1 – General

46 Every company must have at least 1

shareholder

47 Liability of shareholders

48 Decisions that must be made by

shareholders

49 Decisions that may be made by

shareholders

50 Shareholder approval of major transactions

51 Unanimous shareholder approval

52 Shareholder written resolutions

53 Shareholder meetings

Subpart 2 – Alteration of shareholder rights

54 Alteration of shareholder rights

55 Repurchase of dissenter ’s shares

Subpart 3 – Disclosure to shareholders

56 Annual report to shareholders

57 Inspection of company records by

shareholders

58 Request for information held by company

59 Company must provide requested

information

60 Reasons for refusing information

61 Shareholder may withdraw request

62 Court may order company to provide

requested information

63 Investigation at request of shareholder

PART 5

DIRECTORS

Subpart 1 – Powers and duties

Powers

64 Management of company

Duties

65 Fundamental duties of directors

66 Duty of directors to comply with Act

67 Duty of directors to comply with rules

68 Interest of director in company transactions

69 Use and disclosure of company

information

70 Standard of care of directors

71 Obligations of directors in connection with

insolvency

72 Effect of unanimous shareholder approval

on certain duties of directors

73 Persons deemed to be directors for liability

purposes

Companies Act 2006

Personal actions by shareholderss Subpart 4 – Accounting and audit

327

99 Personal actions by shareholders against company

100 Personal actions by shareholders against directors

101 Representative actions

Prejudiced shareholders

102 Prejudiced shareholders

103 Certain conduct deemed prejudicial

104 Alteration to rules by Court

Certain applications

105 Effect of arbitration clause in rules

106 Application for relief by Registrar

PART 7

ADMINISTRATION OF COMPANIES

Subpart 1 – Dealings with third parties

Binding company

107 Authority to bind company

108 Attorneys

109 Validity of dealings with third parties

110 Assumptions that may be made by third

parties

111 Transactions in which directors are

interested

112 Transactions entered into by directors in

breach of certain duties

113 Effect on third parties

Pre-incorporation contracts

114 Pre-incorporation contracts may be ratified

115 Warranties implied in pre-incorporation

contracts

116 Failure to ratify

Subpart 2 – Company records

117 Company records

118 Form of records

119 Alternative locations of records

120 Inspection of records by directors

121 Inspection of records by shareholders

122 Inspection of records by public

123 Manner of inspection

129 Accounting records to be kept

130 Financial statements to be prepared

131 Application

132 Appointment of auditor

133 When auditor ceases to hold office

134 Registrar may appoint auditor on request

of shareholder

135 Qualifications of auditor

136 Statement by auditor in relation to

resignation or removal

137 Auditor to avoid conflict of interest

138 Auditor ’s report

139 Access to information

140 Auditor ’s attendance at shareholders’

meeting

Subpart 5 – Company charges

141 Charges may be registered

PART 8

AMALGAMATIONS, ETC

Subpart 1 – Amalgamations

142 Amalgamations

143 Notice of proposed amalgamation

144 Registration of amalgamation proposal

145 Certificate of amalgamation

146 Effect of certificate of amalgamation

147 Registers

148 Powers of Court in relation to

amalgamations

Subpart 2 – Approval of amalgamations, etc, by

Court

149 Interpretation

150 Approval of amalgamations, etc

151 When Court may approve amalgamations,

etc

152 Initial Court orders

153 Court may make additional orders

154 Copy of orders to be delivered to Registrar

PART 9

INSOLVENT COMPANIES

Subpart 1 – Administrations

Purpose

Subpart 3 – Documents to be sent to

124 Annual returns

125 Registrar may send annual return form to

company

126 Other documents to be sent to Registrar

127 Annual report to shareholders

128 Other documents to be sent to shareholders

156 Purpose

Beginning of Administration

157 When administration begins

Restrictions on Appointment of Administrator

158 Restrictions on appointment of

administrator

328 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

How administrator may be appointed

159 Who may appoint administrator

160 Directors may appoint administrator

161 Liquidator may appoint administrator

162 Secured creditor may appoint

administrator

163 Appointment of administrator not to be

revoked

164 Court may remove administrator

Notices

165 Notices given by administrator

166 Notice given by secured creditor

167 Requirements for notices given under

sections 165 or 166

168 Notice of administration

Investigation of company’s affairs

169 Administrator to investigate company’s

affairs

170 Directors to deliver documents to

administrator

171 Directors to give administrator statement

of company’s affairs

172 Directors must give administrator other

information

173 Offence not to comply with sections 170 to

172

Administrator’s rights to company’s documents

174 Restriction on enforcement of lien over

company’s documents

175 Delivery of company’s documents held by

secured creditor

176 Notice to deliver company’s documents to

administrator

177 Offence not to comply with sections 174 to

176

First creditors’ meeting

178 Preparation for first creditors’ meeting

179 Notice of first creditors’ meeting

180 Proceedings at first creditors’ meeting

181 Offence not to comply with sections 178 or

179

Reports by administrators

182 Reports by administrators

183 Court may direct administrator to lodge

report

Watershed meeting

184 What is watershed meeting

185 Administrator must convene watershed

meeting

186 Notice of watershed meeting

187 When watershed meeting must be held

188 What creditors may decide at watershed

meeting

End of administration

189 When administration ends

190 Normal way for administration to end

191 Other ways in which administration may

end

192 Notice of end of administration

Creditors’ resolution approving compromise

193 Effect of creditors’ resolution approving

compromise

194 Contents of compromise document

195 Application of subpart 2 to compromise

proposed by administrator

196 Notice of approval of compromise

Creditors’ resolution approving appointment of liquidator

197 Creditors’ resolution approving appointment of liquidator

198 Notice of appointment of liquidator

Protection of persons during administration

199 Protection of persons dealing with

administrator, etc

200 Validity of things done during

administration

201 General power to make orders

202 Court order protecting creditors or

shareholders

203 Court orders to protect creditors during

administration

Subpart 2 – Compromises with creditors

204 Compromise proposal

205 Notice of proposed compromise

206 Effect of compromise

207 Variation of compromise

208 Powers of Court

209 Effect of compromise in liquidation of

company

210 Costs of compromise

Subpart 3 – Liquidations

Purpose

211 Purpose

Beginning of liquidation

212 When liquidation begins

Restrictions on appointment of liquidator

213 Restrictions on appointment of liquidator

Companies Act 2006

329

How liquidator may be appointed

214 Board may appoint liquidator

215 Shareholders may appoint liquidator

216 Creditors may appoint liquidator

217 Court may appoint liquidator

218 Interim liquidator

219 Meaning of unable to pay its debts

220 Evidence and other matters

221 Statutory demand

222 Court may set aside statutory demand

223 Additional powers of Court on application

to set aside statutory demand

Notices

224 Notices given by liquidator

225 Documents to state company in liquidation

Obligations to liquidators

226 Directors, etc, to identify and deliver

company property

227 Obligations of suppliers of essential

services

Liquidators’ rights to company’s documents

228 Liquidator may require director, etc, to

deliver documents

229 Liquidator may require director, etc, to

provide information

230 Reasonable expenses may be paid

231 Examination by liquidator

232 Court may order person to comply with

section 228

233 Self-incrimination no excuse

234 Restriction on enforcement of lien over

204 Compromise proposal

235 Delivery of document held by secured

creditor

236 Documents held by receiver

Meetings

237 Notice of first creditors’ meeting

238 Timing of first creditors’ meeting

239 Purpose of first creditors’ meeting

240 Replacement liquidator

241 Effect of directors resolving company able

to pay its debts

242 Other creditors’ meetings

243 Liquidator may dispense with meetings of

creditors

244 Meetings of creditors or shareholders

245 Views of creditors and shareholders at

meetings to be considered

Reports

246 First report

247 Six-monthly reports

248 Exemption from reporting requirements

Creditors’ claims

249 Preferential claims

250 Claims of other creditors and distribution

of surplus assets

End of liquidation

251 Completion of liquidation

252 Final report and accounts

253 Liquidation surplus account

254 Termination of liquidation by Court

255 Notice of termination of liquidation

256 Effect of compromise on liquidation

PART 10

REMOVAL OF COMPANIES FROM REGISTER

257 Removal from register

258 Grounds for removal from register

259 Request for company to be removed from

register

260 Requirements to be met before company

must be removed from register

Notices

261 Notice of intention to remove company that

has ceased to carry on business

262 Contents of notice

263 Notice of intention to remove in other cases

Objections

264 Objection to removal from Niue register

265 Duties of Registrar if objection received

266 Powers of Court

Effect of removal from register

267 Property of company removed from

register

268 Disclaimer of property by Government

269 Effect of disclaimer

270 Liability of directors, shareholders, and

others to continue

271 Liquidation of company removed from

Niue register

Restoration of removed company to Niue register

272 Registrar may restore company to Niue register

273 Requirements to be met before restoring company to Niue register

274 Registrar not to restore company to Niue register if objection received

275 Court directions

276 Court may restore company to Niue

register

330 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

277 Restoration to register

278 Vesting of property in company on

restoration to register

PART 11

OVERSEAS COMPANIES

279 Meaning of carrying on business

280 Name must comply with section 10

281 Overseas companies to register under this

Act

282 Validity of transactions not affected

283 Application for registration

284 Registration of overseas company

285 Use of name by overseas company

286 Further information to be provided by

overseas company

287 Annual return of overseas company

288 Overseas company ceasing to carry on

business in Niue

289 Attorneys of overseas companies

290 Liquidation of assets in Niue

291 Exemption from requirements of this Part

PART 12

TRANSFER OF REGISTRATION

292 Overseas companies may be registered

293 Application for registration

294 Overseas companies must be authorised

to register

295 Overseas companies that cannot be

registered

296 Registration

297 Effect of registration

298 Companies may transfer incorporation

299 Application to transfer incorporation

300 Approval of shareholders

301 Company to give public notice

302 Companies that cannot transfer

incorporation

303 Removal from register

304 Effect of removal from register

PART 13

REGISTRAR OF COMPANIES

Subpart 1 – Registrar

Powers

311 Registrar may require information and

copies of documents

312 Registrar may amend registers

313 Registrar ’s powers of inspection

314 Registrar not to be obstructed

315 Certain Acts not affected by Registrar ’s

power of inspection

316 Disclosure of information and reports

317 Information and report to be given to

Registrar

318 Restrictions on disclosing information

319 Inspector ’s report admissible in liquidation

proceedings

Appeals

320 Appeals

321 Exercise of inspection power not affected

by appeal

322 Destruction and admissibility of

293 Application for registration

Subpart 2 – Registers kept by Registrar

Registers

323 Registers

Inspections of registers

324 Inspection of registers

325 Certified copies

326 Evidence

Registration

327 Registration of documents

328 Rejection of documents

329 When document registered

330 No presumption of validity or invalidity

PART 14

REREGISTRATION OF INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS

COMPANIES

331 Period for reregistration

332 Rules of reregistered company

333 Documents to be filed

334 Effect of reregistration

335 Failure to reregister

305 Registrar

Office

Miscellaneous

PART 15

306 Deputy Registrars

307 Transitional

Notices by Registrar

308 Notices: general

309 Notices to individuals

310 Admissibility of notices given by

Registrar

Subpart 1 – Offences

336 Proceedings for offences

337 False statements on documents

338 Fraudulent use or destruction of company

perty

339 Falsification of records

Companies Act 2006

331

340 Carrying on business fraudulently

Subpart 2 – Privileged communications and service of documents

341 Privileged communications

342 Service of documents on companies in legal

proceedings

343 Service of other documents on companies

344 Service of documents on overseas

companies in legal proceedings

345 Service of other documents on overseas

companies

346 Service of documents on shareholders and

creditors

347 Additional provisions relating to service

348 Regulations

13 Selling shareholder to give written notice to company

14 Company to give written notice to shareholders

15 Written notice is offer by selling shareholder

16 Notice agreeing to purchase shares given within specified time

17 Notice agreeing to purchase shares not given within specified time

18 No shareholder wishes to purchase selling shareholder ’s shares

19 Selling shareholder not obliged to sell some shares

20 Directors may require evidence of terms

Transfer of shares

Subpart 4 – Repeals and

21

Transfer of shares

transitional provisions

22

Share certificates

349 International business companies

350 Repeals and revocations

Meetings of shareholders

23

Meetings of shareholders

SCHEDULE 1

24

Notice of meetings

25

Methods of holding meetings

26

Quorum

27

Chairperson

28

Voting

29

Votes of joint shareholders

30

Proxies

31

Corporations may act by representatives

32

Minutes

Miscellaneous

33 Annual meetings and special meetings of

shareholders

34 Written resolutions of shareholders

35 Voting in interest groups

36 Shareholders entitled to receive

distributions

37 Shareholders entitled to exercise pre­

emptive rights

38 Shareholders entitled to attend and vote at

meetings

39 Distributions to shareholders

40 Company may acquire its own shares and

provide financial assistance

41 Annual report to shareholders

42 Deemed approval by all shareholders for

certain purposes

PART 3

DIRECTORS

43 Appointment and removal of directors

44 Resignation of director

45 Notice of change in directors

332 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

46

Powers and duties of directors

47

Standard of care of directors

48

Obligations of directors in connection with

insolvency

49

Interested directors

50

Use and disclosure of company information

51

Indemnities and insurance for directors or

employees

52

Remuneration of directors

53

Procedure at meetings of directors

54

Chairperson

55

Notice of meeting

56

Methods of holding meetings

57

Quorum

58

Voting

59

Minutes

60

Unanimous resolution

61

Managing director and other executive

directors

62

Delegation to managing director

63

Remuneration of managing director and

director

PART 4

COMPANY RECORDS

64

Company records

65

Form of records

66

Access to records

67

Documents to be sent to Registrar

68

Documents to be sent to shareholders

PART 5

ACCOUNTS AND AUDIT

69

Accounting records to be kept

70

Financial statements to be prepared

71

Appointment of auditor

72

Auditor ’s attendance at shareholders’

meeting

PART 6

LIQUIDATION AND REMOVAL FROM REGISTER

73

Resolution to appoint liquidator

74

Distribution of surplus assets

PART 7

MISCELLANEOUS

75

Service of documents on shareholders

76

Interpretation

SCHEDULE 3

MODEL RULES FOR SINGLE

SHAREHOLDER COMPANY

PART 1

GENERAL PROVISIONS

1

Name of company

Companies Act 2006

333

PART 6

LIQUIDATION AND REMOVAL FROM REGISTER

40

Resolution to appoint liquidator

41

Distribution of surplus assets

PART 7

MISCELLANEOUS

42

Service of documents on shareholder

43

Interpretation

SCHEDULE 4

MODEL RULES FOR PUBLIC COMPANIES

PART 1

GENERAL PROVISIONS

1

Name of company

2

Public company

3

Rules

PART 2

SHARES AND SHAREHOLDERS

General provisions

4

Number of shares

5

Rights attaching to shares

6

Initial issue of shares

7

Process for issuing shares

8

Transferability of shares

Share register

9

Company to keep share register

10

Form and location of share register

11

Status of registered shareholders

Transfer of shares and share certificates

12

Transfer of shares

13

Share certificates

Meetings of shareholders

14

Meetings of shareholders

15

Notice of meetings

16

Methods of holding meetings

17

Quorum

18

Chairperson

19

Voting

20

Votes of joint shareholders

21

Proxies

22

Corporations may act by representatives

23

Postal votes

24

Duty of person authorised to receive and

count postal votes

25

Duty of chairperson concerning postal

votes

26

Minutes

Miscellaneous

27

Annual meetings and special meetings of

shareholders

334 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

4

Short form amalgamation

SCHEDULE 7

COMPANY CHARGES

Preliminary provisions

1

Meaning of registrable charge

2

Charges that are not registrable charges

apply

3

Constructive

notice

of

registered

documents

Rectification of register and extension of time

4 Court orders

5 Grounds for Court orders

Registration

6 Registrable documents

7 Who may apply for registration

8 Time for submitting registrable documents

9 What must accompany copy of registrable

document

Rejection of non-complying document

10 Registrar may reject non-complying

document

11 Consequences of rejecting non-complying

document

Registration of document

12 When document is registered

13 Certificate of registration

14 No presumption of validity

Satisfaction of company charge, etc

15 Entries of satisfaction and release of

property from registered charge of price

for shares

16 Prescribed time for submitting notices

17 Matters on which notice may be deferred

18 Registrar must enter memorandum of

satisfaction in register

19 Court may order entry of memorandum in

register

SCHEDULE 8

POWERS, FUNCTIONS, AND LIABILITIES

OF ADMINISTRATORS

PART 1

PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1 Administrator is company’s agent

2 Administrator has qualified privilege

3 Administrator may seek directions

4 Exercise of powers, etc, by 2 or more

administrators

Companies Act 2006

335

5 Exercise of powers, etc, by 2 or more administrators under compromise

PART 2

POWERS AND FUNCTIONS OF ADMINISTRATORS

6 General powers of administrator

7 Limitations on administrator ’s powers

8 Dealing with property subject to floating

charge that has become fixed charge

9 When administrator may dispose of

encumbered property

PART 3

LIABILITY OF ADMINISTRATORS

General liability

10 Administrator not liable in damages for

refusing consent

11 Liability of administrator for company’s

debts

12 Liability of administrator for debts incurred

by administrator

Liability for rent, etc

13 Application of clauses 14 to 17

14 Liability of administrator for rent

Indemnity

15 Notice stating company does not propose

to exercise rights over property

16 Effect of notice

17 When notice ceases to have effect

Indemnity

18 Administrator is entitled to indemnity

19 Administrator ’s indemnity has priority

over unsecured debts, etc

20 Exception for debts secured by floating

charge

21 Extent of administrator ’s indemnity when

floating charge has priority

SCHEDULE 9

OFFICE OF ADMINISTRATOR

Restrictions on appointment of administrators

1 Who may not be appointed or act as

administrator

2 Validity of acts of administrators

3 Person must consent to being appointed

administrator

4 Court may declare whether administrator

validly appointed

Vacancy in office of administrator

5 Vacancy in office of administrator

6 Replacement administrator to hold

creditors’ meeting

7 Court order if vacancy in office of administrator

8 Vacancy in office of administrator under compromise

Administrator’s remuneration

9 Remuneration of administrator

SCHEDULE 10

EFFECT OF ADMINISTRATION

PART 1

PRELIMINARY PROVISION

1 Time for doing act does not run while act

prevented by administration

PART 2

Effect on company’s officers

and shareholders, etc

2 Functions and powers of company officers

suspended

3 Effect of administration on company’s

shareholders

4 Restrictions on putting company into

propose to exercise rights over property

PART 3

EFFECT ON PROCEEDINGS, ETC

5 Stay of civil proceedings

6 Suspension of enforcement process

7 Duties of court officer in relation to

property of company

8 Court officer must deliver company

property, etc, to administrator

9 Good faith buyer under execution process

gets good title

PART 4

RESTRICTIONS ON DEALING WITH

COMPANYS PROPERTY

General provisions

10 Only administrator may deal with

company’s property

11 Offence for company officer to enter into

void transaction or dealing

12 Order for compensation

13 Owner or lessor not to recover

propertyused by company

14 Exception: perishable property

15 Exception: recovery of property before

administration

16 Court may limit powers of receiver, etc, in

relation to property used by company

17 Giving notice relating to property used by

company

336 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Secured creditors Voting

Companies Act 2006

337

6

No enforcement of rights over company’s

property

7

Restriction on rights of creditors to

complete execution, distraint, or

attachment

8

Duties of court officer in execution process

PART 4

EFFECT ON CERTAIN CONDUCT

9

Certain conduct prohibited

SCHEDULE 16

LIQUIDATION COMMITTEES

PART 1

LIQUIDATION COMMITTEE

1

Appointment of members

2

Membership

3

Powers

4

Application of company’s rules

5

Inability to act

6

Restriction on purchase of company’s

assets by liquidation committee

7

Members not entitled to benefit from

dealings with company’s assets

8

No remuneration

9

Disallowance or recovery of benefits or

payments

PART 2

PROCEEDINGS AT MEETINGS

10

Frequency of meetings

11

Majorities

12

Resignation

13

Office becoming vacant

14

Removal of member

15

Vacancy filled

16

Committee with vacancy may act

SCHEDULE 17

VOIDABLE TRANSACTIONS AND CHARGES

Voidable transactions

1

Definitions

2

Voidable transactions

VOIDABLE CHARGES

3

Definitions

4

Voidable charges

5

Exception: certain kinds of substituted

charges

6

Exception: charge that secures unpaid

purchase price

7

Payments received by secured party

Procedure for setting aside voidable

transactions and charges

commencement of liquidation 8 Procedure

338 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

9 Other orders

10 Additional provisions relating to setting

aside transactions and charges

PART 2

RECOVERY IN OTHER CASES

Transactions at undervalue

11 Definitions

12 Transactions at undervalue

Transactions for inadequate or excessive consideration with directors, etc

13 Definitions

14 Transactions for excessive consideration

with directors, etc

15 Transactions for inadequate consideration

with directors, etc

Court may set aside certain securities and charges

16 Court may set aside certain securities and charges

17 Certain securities exempted

18 Other orders, etc

Contribution for not keeping proper accounting records

19 Contribution for not keeping proper accounting records

20 When Court may not make declaration under clause 19

Court may require persons to repay money or

PART 2

SECURED CLAIMS

7 Powers of secured creditors

8 Realising secured property

9 Valuation of security

10 Liquidator ’s duties on receipt of claim by

secured creditor

11 Liquidator may redeem security

12 Liquidator may require secured creditor to

exercise powers

13 Offence to make false or misleading claim

PART 3

PREFERENTIAL CLAIMS

14 Definitions

15 First priority claims

16 Second priority claims

17 Third priority claims

18 Ranking of claims in clauses 16 and 17

19 When landlord or other person has

distrained on goods, etc

PART 4

MUTUAL CREDIT AND SET-OFF

20 Definitions

21 Mutual credit and set-off

22 Proof for person who is not related

23 Proof for person who is related person

24 Exceptions for amounts paid or payable by

shareholder

PART 5

MISCELLANEOUS

25 Interest on claims

26 Trade discounts

27 Periodical payments

28 Employees’ claims

29 Notice to creditors to claim

30 Failure to claim by day fixed for claims

31 Failure to establish priority by day fixed for

claims

32 Dividends in respect of rejected claims

33 Costs of proceedings relating to

SCHEDULE 19

LIQUIDATION OF ASSETS OF OVERSEAS COMPANIES

1 Modified application of subpart 3 of Part 9

2 Rights of action not affected

SCHEDULE 20

ENACTMENTS REPEALED

SCHEDULE 21

REGULATIONS REVOKED


339

COMPANIES ACT 2006

2006/275 – 1 August 2006

An Act to provide for the formation and governance of companies in Niue

set out in Schedule 1.

4 Overview

In this Act –
(a) This Part deals with preliminary matters;
(b) Part 2 deals with incorporating new companies. It also contains
provisions concerning changes to company names, company rules,
and changes to the registered office and postal address of companies.
Schedules 2 to 4 contain model rules:
(c) Part 3 deals with shares;
(d) Part 4 deals with shareholders. Schedule 5 sets out the procedure
for the minority buy-out procedure;
(e) Part 5 deals with the powers, duties, and liabilities of directors;
(f) Part 6 deals with enforcement;
(g) Part 7 deals with company administration. Subpart 1 sets out
dealings with third parties–– how to bind the company. Subpart 2
relates to company records. Subpart 3 sets out the documents that
must be sent to the Registrar (for example, the annual return) and
the shareholders (for example, the annual report). Subpart 4 sets
out requirements concerning accounting records, financial
statements, and auditors;
(h) Part 8 deals with amalgamations. Further provisions are set out in
Schedule 6;
(i) Part 9 contains various procedures for insolvent companies.
Schedule 7 sets out the procedure and other matters for registering
company charges under this Act. Subpart 1 deals with
administrations. Schedules 8 to 12 supplement that subpart. Subpart
2 deals with compromises with creditors and Schedule 12
supplements that subpart. Subpart 3 deals with liquidations and
Schedules 12 to 18 supplement that subpart;
(j) Part 10 relates to the removal of companies from the Niue register;
(k) Part 11 deals with overseas companies and Schedule 19 (which
relates to the liquidation of the assets of overseas companies)
supplements that Part;
(l) Part 12 relates to the transfer of registration of overseas companies;
(m) Part 13 deals with the Registrar of Companies, the registers under
this Act, and registration requirements;
340 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(n) Part 14 sets out the requirements for reregistering existing international business companies under this Act;
(o) Part 15 sets out some miscellaneous provisions, including some more offence provisions, regulation-making powers, repeals, and transitional and savings provisions. In particular, it provides that no further companies may be incorporated under the International Business Companies Act 1994, with immediate effect, and that that Act and certain related Acts are repealed with effect from 31
December 2006.

5 Act binds the Government

This Act binds the Government.
PART 2
INCORPORATING NEW COMPANIES

Subpart 1 – Incorporation

6 Application for incorporation

(1) An application for incorporation of a company must be made to the
Registrar in the prescribed form.
(2) An application for incorporation of a company must specify –
(a) The name of the company, which must comply with section 10; and
(b) Whether the company is a private company or a public company;
and
(c) Whether the rules of the company differ from the model rules set
out in Schedule 2 (in the case of a private company) or Schedule 4
(in the case of a public company); and
(d) The full name, residential address, and postal address of every
director of the proposed company; and
(e) The full name of every shareholder of the proposed company, and
the number of shares to be issued to every shareholder; and
(f) The registered office of the proposed company; and
(g) The postal address of the company, which may be the registered
office or any other postal address.
(3) An application for incorporation must be accompanied by –
(a) A consent by each person named as a director to act as a director of
the company, in the prescribed form; and
(b) A copy of the rules of the company, if they differ from the model
rules; and
(c) The prescribed fee.

7 Certificate of incorporation

As soon as the Registrar receives an application for incorporation that
complies with section 6, the Registrar must –
(a) Enter the company on the Niue register; and
(b) Issue a certificate of incorporation in respect of the company.

8 Effect of incorporation

(1) A certificate of incorporation of a company is conclusive evidence that –
(a) All the requirements of this Act as to incorporation have been
complied with; and
(b) On and from the date of incorporation stated in the certificate, the
company is incorporated under this Act.

Companies Act 2006

341
(2) A company incorporated under this Act is a legal entity in its own right separate from its shareholders, and continues in existence until it is removed from the Niue register.

9 Registration as private company or public company

(1) A company may be registered as a private company if –
(a) Its rules prohibit it from offering its securities to the public; and
(b) Its rules restrict the number of shareholders in the company to not
more than 100; and
(c) It has not more than 100 shareholders.
(2) A company that is not registered as a private company is a public
company.
(3) A public company may apply to the Registrar to be registered as a
private company if –
(a) The company meets the requirements in subsection (1); and
(b) The application has been approved by shareholders by special
resolution.
(4) If a public company applies to the Registrar under subsection (3), the
Registrar must –
(a) Amend the registration of the company accordingly; and
(b) Issue a new certificate of incorporation for the company in the
prescribed form.
(5) A private company may apply to the Registrar to be registered as a
public company, with the approval of shareholders by special resolution.
(6) A private company must apply to be registered as a public company if
it ceases to meet the requirements in subsection (1).
(7) The Registrar must register the company as a public company, and issue
a new certificate of incorporation for the company in the prescribed form if –
(a) An application is made to the Registrar in accordance with
subsections (5) or (6); or
(b) It comes to the Registrar ’s attention that a private company has
ceased to satisfy the requirements of subsection (1).

10 Name of company

Subpart 2 – Names

(1) The name of a company must end with the word “Limited”. (2) The Registrar must not register a company with a name –
(a) That is identical or almost identical to the name of another company;
or
(b) The use of which would contravene any enactment in relation to
the use of names; or
(c) That contravenes regulations made under this Act in relation to
company names; or
(d) That the Registrar considers to be offensive.
(3) If an application for incorporation of a company specifies a name that
does not meet the requirements of this section, the Registrar must incorporate the
company with a name in the form “Company number x Limited”, where “x” is a
unique number assigned to the company by the Registrar for this purpose.
342 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

11 Change of name

(1) An application to change the name of a company must be –
(a) In the prescribed form; and
(b) Signed by a director of the company; and
(c) Accompanied by the prescribed fee.
(2) An application to change the name of a company is not an amendment
of the rules of the company for the purposes of this Act.
(3) As soon as the Registrar receives a properly completed application
under this section that complies with subsection (1) and with the requirements in
section 10, the Registrar must –
(a) Enter the new name of the company on the Niue register; and
(b) Issue a certificate of incorporation for the company recording the
change of name of the company.
(4) A change of name of a company –
(a) Takes effect from the date specified in the certificate issued under
subsection (3); and
(b) Does not affect rights or obligations of the company, or legal
proceedings by or against the company.
(5) Legal proceedings that might have been continued or commenced
against the company under its former name may be continued or commenced
against it under its new name.

12 Direction to change name

(1) If the Registrar believes on reasonable grounds that a company has
been registered under a name that contravenes section 10 at the time of registration,
the Registrar may serve written notice on the company to change its name by a
date specified in the notice that is not less than 20 working days after the date on
which the notice is served.
(2) If the company does not change its name within the period specified in
the notice, the Registrar may enter on the Niue register a new name for the company
in the form “Company number x Limited”, where “x” is a unique number assigned
to the company by the Registrar for this purpose.
(3) If the Registrar registers a new name under subsection (2) –
(a) The Registrar must issue a certificate of incorporation for the
company recording the new name of the company; and
(b) Section 11(4) applies in relation to the registration of the new name
as if the name of the company had been changed under section 11.

13 Use of company name

(1) A company must ensure that its name is clearly stated in –
(a) Every written communication sent by, or on behalf of, the company;
and
(b) Every document issued or signed by, or on behalf of, the company
that evidences or creates a legal obligation of the company.
(2) If –
(a) A document that evidences or creates a legal obligation of a
company is issued or signed by or on behalf of the company; and
(b) The name of the company is not correctly stated in the document –
every person who issued or signed the document is liable to the same
extent as the company if the company fails to discharge the
obligation.
(3) Subsection (2) does not apply if –

Companies Act 2006

343
(a) The person who issued or signed the document proves that the person in whose favour the obligation was incurred was aware at the time the document was issued or signed that the obligation was incurred by the company; or
(b) The Court is satisfied that it would not be just and equitable for the person who issued or signed the document to be so liable.
(4) For the purposes of subsections (1) to (3) and section 107 (which relates to the manner in which a company may enter into contracts and other obligations), a company may use a generally recognised abbreviation of a word or words in its name if it is not misleading to do so.
(5) If, within the period of 12 months immediately before a company gives public notice of any matter, the name of the company was changed, the company must ensure that the notice states –
(a) That the name of the company was changed in that period; and
(b) The former name or names of the company.
(6) If a company fails to comply with subsections (1) or (5) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

Subpart 3 – Company rules

14 Adoption and alteration of rules

(1) A company may adopt rules at the time of its incorporation by –
(a) Filing those rules with its application for incorporation; or
(b) In the case of model rules set out in Schedules 2, 3, or 4, indicating
in its application for incorporation that it wishes to adopt those
model rules as its rules.
(2) Subject to any restrictions in its rules, a company may, by special
resolution, adopt new rules or alter its rules.
(3) Within 10 working days of the adoption of new rules by a company, or
the alteration of the rules of a company, as the case may be, the company must
deliver a notice in the prescribed form to the Registrar for registration.
(4) If a company fails to comply with subsection (3), every director of the
company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50
penalty units.

15 Model rules

(1) The model rules set out in Schedule 2 have effect as the rules of a private
company except to the extent that the company has –
(a) Adopted the model rules set out in another schedule as its rules; or
(b) Adopted rules that exclude, or modify, or are inconsistent with, the
model rules.
(2) The model rules set out in Schedule 4 have effect as the rules of a public
company except to the extent that the company has –
(a) Adopted the model rules set out in another schedule as its rules; or
(b) Adopted rules that exclude, or modify, or are inconsistent with, the
model rules.
(3) A company may resolve to adopt the model rules in Schedules 2, 3, or
4 as its rules in accordance with section 14(2).
344 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

16 Contents and effect of rules

(1) The rules of a company may contain –
(a) Matters contemplated by this Act for inclusion in the rules of a
company;
(b) Any other matters that the company wishes to include in its rules.
(2) Subject to subsection (3) –
(a) The rules of a company have effect and may be enforced as if they
constituted a contract –
(i) between the company and its shareholders; and
(ii) between the company and each director; and
(b) The shareholders and directors of a company have the rights,
powers, duties, and obligations set out in the rules of the company.
(3) The rules of a company are of no effect to the extent that they are
inconsistent with this Act.

Subpart 4–Registered office and postal address

17 Registered office and postal address

(1) A company must always have a registered office and postal address in
Niue.
(2) Subject to section 18 –
(a) The registered office of a company at a particular time is the place
that is described as its registered office on the Niue register at that
time; and
(b) The postal address of a company at a particular time is the place
that is described as its postal address on the Niue register at that
time.
(3) The description of the registered office of a company must describe the
location of the registered office in enough detail to enable the registered office to be readily identified for the purposes of this Act.

18 Change of registered office and postal address

(1) Subject to the company’s rules and to subsection (3), the directors of a
company may change the registered office and postal address of the company at
any time.
(2) Notice in the prescribed form of the change must be given to the
Registrar for registration.
(3) The change in the registered office or postal address, as the case may
be, takes effect on the later of –
(a) The date that is 5 working days after the notice is received by the
Registrar; or
(b) Any date specified in the notice as the date on which the change is
to be effective.

19 Requirement to change registered office or postal address

(1) Subject to this section, a company must change its registered office or
postal address if it is required to do so by the Registrar.
(2) The Registrar may require a company to change its registered office or
postal address, as the case may be, by notice in writing sent to the company at its
postal address.
(3) The notice must –
(a) State that the company is required to change its registered office or
postal address by a date stated in the notice that is not earlier than

Companies Act 2006

345
20 working days after the date of the notice; and
(b) State the reasons for requiring the change; and
(c) State that the company has the right to appeal to the Court under
this Act; and
(d) be dated and signed by the Registrar.
(4) A copy of the notice must also be sent to each director of the company.
(5) The company must change its registered office or postal address, as the
case may be –
(a) by the date stated in the notice; or
(b) If it appeals to the Court and the appeal is dismissed, within 5
working days after the decision of the Court.
(6) If a company fails to comply with this section –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

20 Legal nature of shares

PART 3
SHARES

General

A share in a company is personal property.

21 No nominal value

(1) A share must not have a nominal or par value.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) prevents the issue by a company of a
redeemable share.

22 Minimum number of shares

Every company must have at least 1 issued share.

23 Rights and powers attached to shares

(1) Subject to the rules of the company and to the terms on which it is
issued, a share in a company confers on the holder –
(a) The right to 1 vote on a poll at a meeting of the company on any
resolution, including any resolution to –
(i) appoint or remove a director or auditor;
(ii) adopt new rules;
(iii) alter the company’s rules;
(iv) approve a major transaction;
(v) approve an amalgamation of the company;
(vi) approve reregistration of a public company as a private
company, or of a private company as a public company;
(vii) put the company into liquidation;
(viii) approve the transfer of registration of the company to another
country;
(b) The right to an equal share in dividends paid by the company;
(c) The right to an equal share in the distribution of the surplus assets
of the company in a liquidation.
(2) Subject to its rules, a company may issue different classes of shares.
(3) Without limiting subsection (2), shares in a company may –
(a) be redeemable; or
346 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Confer preferential rights to distributions of capital or income; or
(c) Confer special, limited, or conditional voting rights; or
(d) Not confer voting rights.

24 Shares must not impose liabilities on holder

(1) A company must not issue a share that is partly paid, or that otherwise
imposes any liability to make a payment to the company on its holder.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) –
(a) Prevents a company from attaching conditions, limits, or restrictions
to the rights and powers attached to the share; or
(b) Prevents a company from issuing a share on credit terms that
provide for a liability to make future payments to the company on
the part of the person to whom it is first issued.

25 Issue of initial shares

A company must –

Issue of shares

(a) Immediately after the registration of the company, issue to any person named in the application for registration as a shareholder the number of shares specified in the application as being the number of shares to be issued to that person or those persons;
(b) In the case of an amalgamated company, immediately after the amalgamation is effective, issue to any person entitled to a share or shares under the amalgamation proposal, the share or shares to which that person is entitled.

26 Issue of other shares

(1) A company may issue shares –
(a) In accordance with its rules; or
(b) With the approval of all shareholders under section 51.
(2) A company must deliver to the Registrar for registration, within 10
working days of the issue of any shares, a notice in the prescribed form of the
issue of the shares by the company.
(3) If the rights attached to the shares are not set out in full in the rules, the
notice must be accompanied by a document setting out the terms of issue of the
shares.
(4) If a company fails to comply with subsection (2), every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

27 Time of issue of shares

A share is issued when the name of the holder is entered on the share register.

Distributions – general

28 Distributions prohibited unless solvency test satisfied

A company must not make a distribution to shareholders unless there are
reasonable grounds for believing that, after that distribution is made, the company
will satisfy the solvency test.

29 Recovery of improper distributions

(1) A distribution made to a shareholder in breach of sections 28, 30, or 31
may be recovered by the company from the shareholder unless –

Companies Act 2006

347
(a) The shareholder received the distribution in good faith and without knowledge of the company’s breach of sections 28, 30, or 31, as the case may be; and
(b) The shareholder has altered the shareholder ’s position in reliance on the validity of the distribution; and
(c) It would be unfair to require repayment in full or at all.
(2) If a distribution has been made in breach of section 28, any person who
authorised the making of the distribution at a time when that person knew, or
ought to have known, that the distribution did not comply with section 28 is liable
to repay to the company so much of that distribution as is not reasonably
recoverable from the recipients under subsection (1).
(3) If, in an action brought under this section, the Court is satisfied that the
company could, by making a distribution of a lesser amount, have satisfied the
requirements of section 28, the Court may permit a shareholder to retain, or excuse
a person who authorised the distribution from liability in respect of, an amount
equal to the value of any distribution that could properly have been made.

30 Dividends

Dividends

(1) Subject to section 28 and to subsection (2), a company may pay a dividend to shareholders if, and only if, that dividend is authorised –
(a) By all shareholders under section 51; or
(b) If the company’s rules so provide, by the directors.
(2) A dividend authorised by the directors must comply with any
conditions or restrictions set out in the rules.
(3) Subject to its rules and to the terms of issue of any share, a company
must not pay a dividend –
(a) In respect of some, but not all, shares; or
(b) That is of a greater value per share in respect of some shares than of
others.
(4) Subsection (3) does not apply if the payment of that dividend in that
manner is approved by all shareholders under section 51.
(5) In this section, dividend means any distribution other than –
(a) A distribution by way of repurchase or redemption of shares; or
(b) A distribution of the surplus assets of the company in a liquidation.

Acquisition of own shares

31 Company may acquire its own shares

(1) A company may acquire its own shares only –
(a) In accordance with subsection (2) or section 55; and
(b) Subject to section 28.
(2) A company may acquire its own shares by agreement with a
shareholder –
(a) In accordance with its rules; or
(b) With the approval of all shareholders under section 51.
(3) A company must deliver to the Registrar for registration, within 10
working days of the acquisition of any shares, a notice in the prescribed form of
the acquisition of the shares by the company.
(4) The notice required under subsection (3) must also be sent to each
shareholder within 20 working days of the acquisition of the shares if an acquisition
of shares by a company does not result from an offer made to all shareholders
that –
348 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) Would, if accepted, leave unaffected relative voting and distribution rights; and
(b) Affords a reasonable time for acceptance of the offer.
(5) If a company fails to comply with subsections (3) or (4), every director
of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 50 penalty units.

32 Cancellation of shares acquired by company

(1) If a company acquires its own shares, those shares are deemed to be
cancelled immediately on acquisition unless the rules of the company expressly
provide otherwise.
(2) If a company acquires its own shares and the rules provide that those
shares are not cancelled on acquisition, the rights attached to those shares may
not be exercised by or against the company at any time at which it would, apart
from this section, be entitled to –
(a) Exercise those rights; or
(b) Give directions to the holder of that share as to the manner in which
any of those rights should be exercised.
(3) For the purposes of this section, a company acquires a share at the time
at which it would, apart from this section, become entitled to –
(a) Exercise the rights attached to that share; or
(b) Give directions to the holder of that share as to the manner in which
any rights attached to that share should be exercised.

33 Enforcement of contract to repurchase shares

(1) A contract with a company providing for the acquisition by the company
of its shares is specifically enforceable against the company except to the extent
that performance would breach section 28.
(2) The company has the burden of proving that performance of the contract
would breach section 28.
(3) Until the company has fully performed a contract referred to in
subsection (1), the other party to the contract retains the status of a claimant entitled
to be paid as soon as the company is lawfully able to do so or, before the removal
of the company from the Niue register, to be ranked subordinate to the rights of
creditors but in priority to the other shareholders.

34 Redeemable shares

Redeemable shares

(1) For the purposes of this Act, a share is redeemable if the rules or the terms of issue of the share make provision for the redemption of that share by the company –
(a) At the option of the company; or
(b) At the option of the holder of the share; or
(c) On a date specified in the rules or the terms of issue of the share –
for a consideration that is –
(d) Specified; or
(e) To be calculated by reference to a formula; or
(f) Required to be fixed by a suitably qualified person who is not
associated with, or interested in, the company.
(2) To avoid doubt, the auditor of a company is not associated with, or
interested in, the company for the purposes of subsection (1)(f).

Companies Act 2006

349

35 Redemption of redeemable shares

(1) A company must redeem a redeemable share in accordance with its
rules and the terms of issue of the share, except to the extent that the company
would, by doing so, breach section 28.
(2) The company has the burden of proving that redemption of a share
would breach section 28.
(3) Until the company has fully redeemed a share in accordance with
subsection (1), the former holder of the share retains the status of a claimant entitled
to be paid as soon as the company is lawfully able to do so or, before the removal
of the company from the Niue register, to be ranked subordinate to the rights of
creditors but in priority to the other shareholders.
(4) Redeemable shares are deemed to be cancelled immediately on the date
on which the rules or their terms of issue provide for them to be redeemed, unless
the rules or terms of issue provide otherwise.
(5) A company must deliver to the Registrar for registration, within 10
working days of the redemption of any shares, a notice in the prescribed form of
the redemption of the shares by the company.
(6) If a company fails to comply with subsection (5), every director of the
company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 10
penalty units.

Assistance by company in purchase of its own shares

36 Financial assistance

A company may give financial assistance to a person for the purpose of, or
in connection with, the purchase of a share issued or to be issued by the company,
whether directly or indirectly, only if –
(a) The company gives the assistance in the normal course of its
business and on usual terms and conditions; or
(b) The giving of the assistance is authorised by the directors or by all
shareholders under section 51, and –
(i) there are reasonable grounds for believing that, after providing
the assistance, the company will satisfy the solvency test; and
(ii) the company complies with any conditions or restrictions in
its rules.

37 Cross-holdings

Cross-holdings

(1) Subject to this section, a subsidiary must not hold shares in its holding company.
(2) An issue of shares by a holding company to its subsidiary is void and of no effect.
(3) A transfer of shares in a holding company to its subsidiary is void and of no effect.
(4) If a company that holds shares in another company becomes a
subsidiary of that other company, the subsidiary –
(a) May, despite subsection (1), continue to hold those shares; but
(b) May not exercise any voting rights or other rights attaching to those
shares, other than rights to receive distributions and to receive
notices and other information from the company.
(5) Nothing in this section prevents a subsidiary holding shares in its
holding company in its capacity as a personal representative or a trustee unless
350 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
the holding company or another subsidiary has a beneficial interest under the trust other than an interest that arises by way of security for the purposes of a transaction made in the ordinary course of the business of lending money.
(6) This section applies to a nominee for a subsidiary in the same way as it applies to the subsidiary.

38 Transfer of shares

Transfer of shares

(1) Subject to any limitation or restriction on the transfer of shares in the rules, a share in a company is transferable.
(2) A share is transferred by entry in the share register in accordance with section 40.
(3) The personal representative of a deceased shareholder may transfer a share even though the personal representative is not a shareholder at the time of transfer.

39 Transfer of shares by operation of law

(1) Subject to subsection (2), shares in a company may pass by operation
of law despite anything in the rules of the company.
(2) The rules of a company may provide that, if a share passes by operation
of law, the voting rights attached to that share cease to be exercisable until it is
transferred in accordance with the rules of the company.

Share register

40 Company to maintain share register

(1) A company must maintain a share register that records the shares issued
by the company and states –
(a) The names, alphabetically arranged, and the last known address of
each person who is, or has within the last 7 years been, a shareholder;
and
(b) The number of shares of each class held by each shareholder within
the last 7 years; and
(c) The date of any issue of shares to, repurchase or redemption of
shares from, or transfer of shares by or to, each shareholder within
the last 7 years, and in relation to the transfer, the name of the person
to or from whom the shares were transferred.
(2) The share register must be kept –
(a) In a form permitted under section 118; and
(b) At the registered office of the company, or any other place or places
permitted under section 119.
(3) The share register of the company may be maintained by an agent on
behalf of the company.
(4) If a company fails to comply with the requirements of this section –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

41 Share register as evidence of legal title

(1) Subject to section 42, the entry of the name of a person in the share
register as holder of a share is evidence that legal title to the share vests in that
person.
(2) A company must treat the registered holder of a share as the only person

Companies Act 2006

entitled to –
(a) Exercise the right to vote attaching to the share; and
(b) Receive notices; and
(c) Receive a distribution in respect of the share; and
(d) Exercise the other rights and powers attaching to the share.
351

42 Power of Court to rectify share register

(1) If the name of a person is wrongly entered in, or omitted from, the
share register of a company, the person aggrieved, or a shareholder, may apply to
the Court for rectification of the share register, or compensation for loss sustained,
or both.
(2) The Court may, on an application under this section, order –
(a) Rectification of the register;
(b) Payment of compensation by the company or a director of the
company for any loss sustained;
(c) Rectification and payment of compensation.
(3) The Court may, on an application under this section, decide –
(a) A question relating to the entitlement of a person who is a party to
the application to have his or her name entered in, or omitted from,
the register; and
(b) A question necessary or expedient to be decided for rectification of
the register.

43 Trusts not to be entered on register

No notice of a trust, whether express, implied, or constructive, may be
entered on the share register.

44 Registration of personal representative or assignee of bankrupt

(1) Despite section 43, but subject to section 39, a personal representative
of a deceased person whose name is registered in a share register of a company as
the holder of a share in that company is entitled to be registered as the holder of
that share as personal representative.
(2) Despite section 43, but subject to section 39(2), the assignee of the
property of an insolvent natural person registered in a share register of a company
as the holder of a share in that company is entitled to be registered as the holder of
that share as the assignee of the property of that person.
(3) The registration of a trustee, executor, administrator, or of an assignee
under this section does not constitute notice of a trust.
(4) For the purposes of this section, assignee means a person in whom the
property of an insolvent natural person is vested pursuant to insolvency legislation
applicable to that natural person.

45 Share certificates

Share certificates

(1) A shareholder may apply to the company for a share certificate relating to some or all of the shareholder ’s shares in the company.
(2) On receipt of an application for a share certificate under subsection (1),
the company must, within 20 working days after receiving the application –
(a) If the application relates to some but not all of the shares, separate
the shares shown in the register as owned by the applicant into
separate parcels; 1 parcel being the shares to which the share
certificate relates, and the other parcel being any remaining shares;
and
352 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) In all cases send to the shareholder a certificate stating – (i) The name of the company; and
(ii) the class of shares held by the shareholder; and
(iii) the number of shares held by the shareholder to which the
certificate relates.
(3) If a share certificate has been issued, a transfer of the shares to which it
relates must not be registered by the company unless the form of transfer required
by that section is accompanied by –
(a) The share certificate relating to the share; or
(b) Evidence as to its loss or destruction and, if required, an indemnity
in a form required by the board.
(4) If shares to which a share certificate relates are to be transferred, and
the share certificate is sent to the company to enable the registration of the transfer,
the share certificate must be cancelled and no further share certificate issued except
at the request of the transferee.
(5) If a company fails to comply with subsection (2) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.
Part 4
SHAREHOLDERS

Subpart 1 – General

46 Every company must have at least 1 shareholder

A company must, at all times, have at least 1 shareholder.

47 Liability of shareholders

(1) A shareholder is not liable for an obligation of the company by reason
only of being a shareholder.
(2) The liability of a shareholder to the company is limited to –
(a) Any liability to repay a distribution that is recoverable under section
29;
(b) Any liability under section 73.
(3) Nothing in this section affects the liability of a shareholder to a company
under a contract (including a contract for the issue of shares) or liability incurred
in any other capacity (including as a director of the company) or liability for any
tort, or breach of a fiduciary duty, or other actionable wrong committed by the
shareholder.

48 Decisions that must be made by shareholders

The following powers must be exercised by the shareholders of a company
by special resolution, and may not be delegated under the rules or otherwise –
(a) The power to approve reregistration of a public company as a private
company under section 9(3), or of a private company as a public company under
section 9(5);
(b) The power to adopt new rules, or to amend the company’s rules,
under section 14(2);
(c) The power to approve an amalgamation of the company under
section 144 and Schedule 6;
(d) The power to approve a major transaction under section 50(1)(b)(i);
(e) The power to put the company into liquidation;

Companies Act 2006

353
(f) The power to approve an extension of time for the completion of a private company’s financial statements under section 130(3);
(g) The power to approve the transfer of registration of the company to another country under section 298.

49 Decisions that may be made by shareholders

(1) Unless the rules provide otherwise, the following powers are exercised
by shareholders –
(a) The power to appoint or remove a director;
(b) The power to appoint an auditor.
(2) The rules may provide for other matters to be decided by shareholders,
or approved by shareholders.
(3) Unless the rules provide otherwise, the powers referred to in subsection
(1), and any other powers conferred on shareholders under subsection (2), may be
exercised –
(a) by ordinary resolution; or
(b) In accordance with section 51.

50 Shareholder approval of major transactions

(1) A company must not enter into a major transaction unless –
(a) The rules expressly authorise it to enter into that transaction, or
transactions of that class; or
(b) Entry into the transaction is approved by shareholders –
(i) by special resolution; or
(ii) in accordance with section 51; or
(c) The transaction is conditional on approval by shareholders in
accordance with paragraph (b).
(2) In this section – assets includes property of any kind, whether tangible
or intangible major transaction, in relation to a company, means –
(a) The acquisition of, or an agreement to acquire, whether contingent
or not, assets the value of which is more than half the value of the
company’s assets before the acquisition; or
(b) The disposition of, or an agreement to dispose of, whether
contingent or not, assets of the company the value of which is more
than half the value of the company’s assets before the disposition;
or
(c) A transaction that has, or is likely to have, the effect of the company
acquiring rights or interests or incurring obligations or liabilities
the value of which is more than half the value of the company’s
assets before the transaction.
(3) Nothing in paragraph (c) of the definition of major transaction in
subsection (2) applies by reason only of the company giving, or entering into an
agreement to give, a charge secured over assets of the company the value of which
is more than half the value of the company’s assets for the purpose of securing the
repayment of money or the performance of an obligation.
(4) Nothing in this section applies to a major transaction entered into by a
receiver appointed under a document creating a charge over property of a company.
354 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

51 Unanimous shareholder approval

(1) If all the shareholders of a company consent to or concur in any action
taken by the company or a director, the taking of that action is deemed to be validly
authorised by the company despite –
(a) Anything to the contrary in its rules; or
(b) The absence of express authority to take that action in its rules.
(2) The matters that may be authorised in accordance with subsection (1)
include, but are not limited to, the following –
(a) The issue of shares;
(b) The making of a distribution;
(c) The repurchase of shares;
(d) Giving financial assistance for the purpose of, or in connection with,
the purchase of shares in the company;
(e) The payment of remuneration to a director, or the making of a loan
to a director, or the conferral of any other benefit on a director;
(f) The making of a contract between the company and a director, or
of any other contract in which a director has an interest;
(g) Entry into a major transaction;
(h) The ratification after the event of any action that could have been
authorised under this section.
(3) A company must not authorise a distribution under this section unless
there are reasonable grounds for believing that, after that distribution is made,
the company will satisfy the solvency test.
(4) Section 29 applies to a distribution made in breach of subsection (3) as
if –
(a) The distribution had been made in breach of section 28; and
(b) The distribution was authorised by all shareholders.

52 Shareholder written resolutions

(1) Subject to subsection (3), a resolution in writing signed by shareholders
who together hold not less than 75% of the votes entitled to be cast on that resolution
at a meeting of shareholders is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of
those shareholders.
(2) A resolution in writing is made in accordance with this Act or the rules
of the company, as the case may be, if the resolution –
(a) Relates to a matter that is required by this Act or by the rules to be
decided at a meeting of the shareholders of a company; and
(b) Is signed by the shareholders referred to in subsection (1).
(3) If, in respect of any matter, the rules of a company –
(a) Require approval by a higher majority than 75% of those
shareholders entitled to vote and voting, the reference in subsection
(1) to 75% is taken to be a reference to that higher majority;
(b) Specify additional requirements for approval of such matters, those
requirements must also be satisfied in order for the resolution to be
valid.
(4) Within 5 working days of a resolution being passed under this section,
the company must send a copy of the resolution to every shareholder who did not
sign the resolution.
(5) A resolution may be signed under subsections (1) or (2) without any
prior notice being given to shareholders.
(6) If a company fails to comply with subsection (4) –

Companies Act 2006

355
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

53 Shareholder meetings

(1) The rules of a company must include provisions –
(a) For holding meetings of shareholders of the company; and
(b) That govern proceedings at meetings of shareholders of the
company.
(2) Meetings of the shareholders of a company must be held in accordance
with the rules of the company.
(3) A special meeting of shareholders entitled to vote on an issue –
(a) May be called at any time by a director; and
(b) Must be called by the directors on the written request of
shareholders holding shares carrying together not less than 5% of
the votes that may be cast on the issue.

Subpart 2 – Alteration of shareholder rights

54 Alteration of shareholder rights

(1) A company must not take action that affects the rights attached to shares
unless that action has been approved by –
(a) A special resolution of each interest group; or
(b) All shareholders under section 51.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), the rights attached to a share
include –
(a) The rights, privileges, limitations, and conditions attached to the share by this Act or the rules, including voting rights and rights to distributions;
(b) The right to have any provisions of the rules in relation to the issue of further shares observed by the company;
(c) The right to have the procedure set out in this section, and any
further procedure required by the rules for the amendment or
alteration of rights, observed by the company;
(d) The right that a procedure required by the rules for the amendment
or alteration of rights not be amended or altered.
(3) In this section –
class means a class of shares having attached to them identical rights,
privileges, limitations, and conditions
interest group, in relation to any action or proposal affecting rights attached
to shares, means a group of shareholders –
(a) whose affected rights are identical; and
(b) Whose rights are affected by the action or proposal in the same
way; and
(c) Subject to subsection (4)(b), who comprise the holders of 1 or more
classes of shares in the company.
(4) For the purposes of this section and the definition of
interest group –
(a) 1 or more interest groups may exist in relation to any action or
proposal; and
(b) Holders of shares in the same class may fall into 2 or more interest
356 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
groups if –
(i) action is taken in relation to some holders of shares in a class
and not others; or
(ii) a proposal expressly distinguishes between some holders of
shares in a class and other holders of shares of that class.

55 Repurchase of dissenter’s shares

(1) A shareholder is entitled to require the company to purchase shares in
accordance with the procedure set out in Schedule 5 if –
(a) The shareholder is entitled to vote on the exercise of 1 or more of
the powers set out in –
(i) section 48(b) and the proposed alteration imposes or removes
a restriction on the activities of the company; or
(ii) section 48(c) or (d); and
(b) The shareholders resolve to exercise the power; and
(c) The shareholder cast all the votes attached to shares registered in
the shareholder ’s name and having the same beneficial owner
against the exercise of the power.
(2) A shareholder is entitled to require the company to purchase shares in
accordance with the procedure set out in Schedule 5 if –
(a) An interest group of which the shareholder was a member has,
under section 54, approved, by special resolution, the taking of
action that affects the rights attached to those shares; and
(b) The company becomes entitled to take the action; and
(c) The shareholder cast all the votes attached to the shares registered
in that shareholder ’s name and having the same beneficial owner
against approving the action.
(3) If a resolution of shareholders or of an interest group is made in writing
in accordance with section 52, subsections (1) and (2) apply as if references to a
shareholder who cast all the votes attached to shares registered in the shareholder ’s
name and having the same beneficial owner against the matter in question were
references to a shareholder who did not sign the written resolution in respect of
those shares.

Subpart 3 – Disclosure to shareholders

56 Annual report to shareholders

(1) Subject to subsection (2), the directors of every company must, within
20 working days after the date on which the company is required to complete its
financial statements under section 130 –
(a) Prepare an annual report on the affairs of the company during the
accounting period ending on that date; and
(b) Send a copy of that report to each shareholder.
(2) The rules of a private company may provide that the directors are only
required to prepare an annual report in respect of an accounting period if a
shareholder has given written notice to the company before the end of that
accounting period requiring the annual report to be prepared.
(3) Every annual report for a company must –
(a) be in writing and be dated; and
(b) Include financial statements for the accounting period that comply
with section 130; and
(c) If an auditor ’s report is required for the financial statements
included in the report, include that auditor ’s report; and

Companies Act 2006

357
(d) State the names of the persons holding office as directors of the company as at the end of the accounting period and the names of any persons who ceased to hold office as directors of the company during the accounting period; and
(e) Contain any other information that may be required by – (i) regulations made under this Act; and
(ii) the rules; and
(f) be signed on behalf of the directors by 2 directors of the company
or, if the company has only 1 director, by that director.
(4) If the directors of a company fail to comply with subsection (1), every
director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine
not exceeding 50 penalty units.

57 Inspection of company records by shareholders

A shareholder is entitled to inspect company records in accordance with
section 121.

58 Request for information held by company

(1) A shareholder may, at any time, make a written request to a company
for information held by the company.
(2) The request must specify the information sought in enough detail to
enable it to be identified.

59 Company must provide requested information

(1) Within 10 working days of receiving a request under section 58, the
company must –
(a) Provide the information; or
(b) Agree to provide the information within a specified period; or
(c) Agree to provide the information within a specified period if the
shareholder pays a reasonable charge to the company (which must
be specified and explained) to meet the cost of providing the
information; or
(d) Refuse to provide the information, specifying the reasons for the
refusal.

60 Reasons for refusing information

Without limiting the reasons for which a company may refuse to provide
information under section 59, a company may refuse to provide information if
the –
(a) Disclosure of the information would be likely to prejudice the commercial position of the company; or
(b) Disclosure of the information would be likely to prejudice the commercial position of any other person, whether or not that person supplied the information to the company; or
(c) Request for the information is frivolous or vexatious.

61 Shareholder may withdraw request

If the company requires the shareholder to pay a charge for the information,
the shareholder may withdraw the request, and is deemed to have done so unless,
within 10 working days of receiving notification of the charge, the shareholder
informs the company that the shareholder –
358 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) Will pay the charge; or
(b) Considers the charge to be unreasonable.

62 Court may order company to provide requested information

(1) The Court may, on the application of a person who has requested
information, make an order requiring the company to provide the information
within any time and on payment of any charge that the Court thinks fit if it is
satisfied that –
(a) The company does not have sufficient reason to refuse to provide
the information; or
(b) The period specified for providing the information is unreasonable;
or
(c) The charge set by the company is unreasonable.
(2) If the Court makes an order under subsection (1), it may specify the
use that may be made of the information and the persons to whom it may be
disclosed.
(3) On an application for an order under this section, the Court may make
any order for the payment of costs that it thinks fit.

63 Investigation at request of shareholder

(1) On the application of a shareholder of a company, the Court may make –
(a) An order authorising a person named in the order, at a time specified
in the order, to inspect and to make copies of, or take extracts from,
the records or other documents of the company, or any of the records
or documents of the company specified in the order; and
(b) Any ancillary order that it thinks fit, including an order that the
accounts of the company be audited by that person.
(2) The Court may make an order under subsection (1) only if it is satisfied
that –
(a) In making the application, the shareholder is acting in good faith and that the inspection is proposed to be made for a proper purpose; and
(b) The person to be appointed is a proper person for the task.
(3) A person appointed by the Court under subsection (1) must diligently
carry out the inspection and, having done so, must make a full report to the Court. (4) On receiving the report of an inspector, the Court may make any order
in relation to the disclosure and use that may be made of the records and information obtained that it thinks fit.
(5) An order made under subsection (4) may be varied from time to time. (6) The reasonable costs of the inspection must be met by the company
unless the Court orders otherwise.
(7) A person may only disclose or make use of information or records
obtained under this section in accordance with an order made under subsections
(4) or (5).
(8) A person who discloses or makes use of information or records obtained
under this section other than in accordance with an order made under subsections
(4) or (5) commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50
penalty units.

Companies Act 2006

PART 5
DIRECTORS

Subpart 1 – Powers and duties

POWERS
359

64 Management of company

Except to the extent that this Act or the company’s rules provide otherwise –
(a) The business and affairs of a company must be managed by, or
under the direction or supervision of, the directors of the company;
and
(b) The directors of a company have all the powers necessary for
managing, and for directing and supervising the management of,
the business and affairs of the company.
DUTIES

65 Fundamental duties of directors

Every director of a company must, when exercising powers or performing
duties as a director, act –
(a) In good faith; and
(b) In a manner that the director believes to be in the interests of the
company.

66 Duty of directors to comply with Act

A director of a company must not act, or agree to the company acting, in a
manner that contravenes this Act.

67 Duty of directors to comply with rules

A director of a company must not act, or agree to the company acting, in a
manner that contravenes the company’s rules.

68 Interest of director in company transactions

(1) A director must not exercise any power as a director if the director is
directly or indirectly materially interested in the exercise of that power, unless –
(a) This Act expressly authorises the director to exercise the relevant
power despite that interest; or
(b) The director has reasonable grounds for believing that the company
will satisfy the solvency test after that power is exercised, and
either –
(i) the rules expressly authorise the director to exercise the relevant
power despite that interest, following disclosure of the interest
in accordance with subsection (2); or
(ii) the exercise of the power by the director has been approved by
all shareholders under section 51, following disclosure of the
nature and extent of the director ’s interest to all shareholders
who are not otherwise aware of those matters.
(2) A director who is directly or indirectly materially interested in the
exercise of any power may only be authorised by the rules to exercise that power
if the rules require that, before the exercise of the power, the director discloses the
nature and extent of that interest in writing –
(a) If there is at least 1 other director who is not directly or indirectly
materially interested in the transaction or proposed transaction, to
the directors of the company;
360 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) If paragraph (a) does not apply, to all shareholders other than the director.

69 Use and disclosure of company information

A director of a company who has information in his or her capacity as a
director or employee of the company, being information that would not otherwise
be available to him or her, must not disclose that information to any person, or
make use of or act on the information, except –
(a) In the interests of the company; or
(b) As required by law; or
(c) If there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company will
satisfy the solvency test after the director takes that action and that
action –
(i) is authorised by the rules; or
(ii) is approved by shareholders under section 51.

70 Standard of care of directors

Subject to the company’s rules, a director of a company, when exercising
powers or performing duties as a director, must exercise the care, diligence, and
skill that a reasonable person would exercise in the same circumstances taking
into account, but without limitation –
(a) The nature of the company; and
(b) The nature of the decision; and
(c) The position of the director and the nature of the responsibilities
undertaken by him or her.

71 Obligations of directors in connection with insolvency

(1) A director of a company must call a meeting of directors within 10
working days to consider whether the directors should appoint an administrator
or liquidator if the director –
(a) Believes that the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall due
in the normal course of business; or
(b) Is aware of matters that would put any reasonable person on inquiry
as to whether the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall
due in the normal course of business.
(2) At a meeting called under this section, the directors must consider
whether to appoint an administrator or liquidator or to continue to carry on the
business of the company.
(3) A director is liable to any creditor to whom the company incurred an
obligation after the time that the director failed to comply with subsection (1) if –
(a) At the time of that failure, the company was unable to pay its debts
as they fell due in the normal course of business; and
(b) The company is later placed in liquidation.
(4) Each director who did not participate in the meeting and did not vote
in favour of appointing an administrator or a liquidator is liable to any creditor to
whom the company incurred an obligation after the date of the meeting in
accordance with subsection (5) if –
(a) At a meeting called under this section, the directors do not resolve
to appoint an administrator or liquidator; and
(b) At the time of that meeting there were no reasonable grounds for
believing that the company was able to pay its debts as they fell
due; and

Companies Act 2006

361
(c) The company is later placed in liquidation.
(5) A director who is liable to a creditor under subsections (3) or (4) in
respect of an obligation of the company is liable to that creditor for the amount of
any loss suffered by that creditor as a consequence of the company’s failure to
perform that obligation, unless the director establishes that the creditor –
(a) Knew or ought to have known of the circumstances that called into
question the solvency of the company; or
(b) Otherwise assumed the risk of dealing with the company in those
circumstances.
(6) If more than 1 director is liable to a creditor under this section, the
liability of those directors is joint and several.

72 Effect of unanimous shareholder approval on certain duties of directors If a director exercises any power or takes any other action in his or her capacity as a director with the consent or concurrence of shareholders under section

51 –
(a) The director is deemed to be acting in accordance with the requirements of section 67; and
(b) If, at the time the director so acts, there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is able to meet its debts as they fall due, the director is deemed to be acting in accordance with the requirements of sections 65 and 70.

Subpart 2 – Liabilities

73 Persons deemed to be directors for liability purposes

(1) A person (principal) in accordance with whose directions or instructions
a director is required or is accustomed to act is liable under sections 65 to 71 to the
same extent as that director, unless the principal shows that the director was not
in fact acting in accordance with the principal’s directions or instructions in acting
or failing to act in the manner giving rise to liability on the part of the director.
(2) A person who exercises, or who is entitled to exercise, or who controls
or who is entitled to control the exercise, of powers that, apart from the rules of
the company, would fall to be exercised by the directors, is liable under sections
65 to 70 in connection with the exercise of those powers as if that person were a
director.
(3) Without limiting subsection (2), if the rules of a company confer a power
on shareholders that would otherwise fall to be exercised by directors under this
Act, any shareholder who exercises that power or who takes part in deciding
whether to exercise that power is liable under sections 65 to 70 in connection with
the exercise of that power as if that person were a director.
(4) A person to whom a power or duty of the directors has been directly
delegated by the directors with that person’s consent or acquiescence, or who
exercises the power or duty with the consent or acquiescence of the directors, is
liable under sections 65 to 70 in connection with the exercise of those powers as if
that person were a director.
(5) To avoid doubt, if any action is approved by all shareholders under
section 51 –
(a) No shareholder is liable under section 67 in respect of that action;
(b) If there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company is
able to meet its debts as they fall due, no shareholder is liable under
sections 65 or 68 or 69 or 70 in respect of that action.
362 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Indemnities and insurance for directors

74 Certain indemnities prohibited

(1) A company may not indemnify a director of the company or of any
related company in respect of –
(a) Any criminal liability; or
(b) Any liability to the company or a related company for any act or
omission in his or her capacity as a director of the company or of
the related company, as the case may be; or
(c) Any liability to any person arising out of a breach by that person of
a duty to the company or related company, as the case may be,
under any of sections 65 to 71.
(2) An indemnity given in breach of this section is void.
(3) In this section –
director includes –
(a) A person who is liable under any of sections 65 to 71 by virtue of
section 73;
(b) A former director
indemnify includes relieve or excuse from liability, whether before or after the
liability arises; and indemnity has a corresponding meaning.

75 Company may indemnify or insure directors

Subject to section 74, a company may provide an indemnity or purchase
insurance for a director of the company or of a related company –
(a) In accordance with its rules; or
(b) With the approval of shareholders under section 51.

76 Defences for directors

Defences

(1) It is a defence to a director charged with an offence in relation to a duty imposed on the directors of a company if the director proves that –
(a) The directors took all reasonable and proper steps to ensure that the requirements would be complied with; or
(b) The director took all reasonable and proper steps to ensure that the directors complied with the requirements; or
(c) In the circumstances, the director could not reasonably have been
expected to take steps to ensure that the directors complied with
the requirements.
(2) It is a defence to a director charged with an offence in relation to a duty
imposed on the company if the director proves that –
(a) The company took all reasonable and proper steps to ensure that
the requirements would be complied with; or
(b) The director took all reasonable steps to ensure that the company
complied with the requirements; or
(c) In the circumstances, the director could not reasonably have been
expected to take steps to ensure that the company complied with
the requirements.

Companies Act 2006

363

Subpart 3 – Prohibition and disqualification of directors

77 Persons prohibited from managing companies

(1) A person must not, during the period of 5 years after the conviction or
the judgment, be a director or promoter of, or in any way, whether directly or
indirectly, be concerned or take part in the management of, a company if the person
has been convicted of an offence –
(a) In connection with the promotion, formation, or management of a
company punishable by imprisonment for a term exceeding 2 years,
whether or not a sentence of imprisonment was imposed; or
(b) Under any of sections 337 to 340 of this Act or under any of sections
180 to 183, 191 to 205A, or 207 to 211 of the Niue Act 1966.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the person first obtains the leave of the
Court, which may be given on any conditions that the Court thinks fit.
(3) A person who intends to apply for the leave of the Court under
subsection (2) must give to the Registrar not less than 10 working days’ notice of
that person’s intention to apply.
(4) The Registrar, and any other persons that the Court thinks fit, may
attend and be heard at the hearing of any application under this section.
(5) Every person who fails to comply with this section or any order made
under this section, commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 7 years or to a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty units, or
both.
(6) In this section, company includes an overseas company that carries on business in Niue.

78 Court may disqualify directors

(1) The Court may make an order that a person must not, without the leave
of the Court, be a director or promoter of, or in any way, whether directly or
indirectly, be concerned or take part in the management of, a company for any
period, not exceeding 10 years, that may be specified in the order if the person
has –
(a) Been convicted of any offence in connection with the promotion, formation, or management of a company punishable by imprisonment for a term exceeding 2 years, whether or not a sentence of imprisonment was imposed; or
(b) Been convicted of an offence under any of sections 337 to 340 of this Act or under any of sections 180 to 183, 191 to 205A, or 207 to
211 of the Niue Act 1966; or
(c) Committed an offence for which the person is liable (whether
convicted or not) under this Part; or
(d) While a director of a company and whether convicted or not –
(i) persistently failed to comply with this Act, or, if the company
has failed to so comply, persistently failed to take all reasonable
steps to obtain compliance; or
(ii) been guilty of fraud in relation to the company or of a breach
of duty to the company or a shareholder; or
(iii) acted in a reckless or incompetent manner in the performance
of his or her duties as director; or
(e) Been convicted of an offence in any other country that corresponds
to the offences referred to in paragraphs (a) to (c); or
364 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(f) Been prohibited under the law of any other country from acting as a director of a company, or being concerned or taking part in the management of a company; or
(g) Become of unsound mind.
(2) An order may be made under this section even though the person
concerned may be criminally liable in respect of the matters on the ground of
which the order is to be made.
(3) The Registrar of the Court must, as soon as practicable after the making
of an order under this section, give notice to the Registrar that the order has been
made and the Registrar must give public notice of the name of the person against
whom the order is made.
(4) Every person who fails to comply with an order under this section
commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 7 years or to a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty units, or both.
(5) In this section and sections 79 and 80, company includes an overseas
company.

79 Persons entitled to apply for order under section 78

(1) An application for an order under section 78 may be made by the
Registrar, or by the liquidator of the company, or by a person who is, or has been,
a shareholder or creditor of the company.
(2) The Registrar or liquidator must appear and call the attention of the
Court to any matters that seem to him or her to be relevant, and may give evidence
or call witnesses on the hearing of an application for –
(a) An order under section 78 by the Registrar or the liquidator; or
(b) Leave under section 78 by a person against whom an order has
been made on the application of the Registrar or the liquidator.

80 Notice of application for order under section 78

(1) A person who intends to apply for an order under section 78 must give
not less than 10 working days’ notice of that intention to the person against whom
the order is sought.
(2) On the hearing of the application, the person against whom the order
is sought may appear and give evidence or call witnesses.

81 Application of sections 82 to 84

Sections 82 to 84 apply to a company –
(a) That has been put into liquidation because of its inability to pay its
debts as and when they became due;
(b) The liquidation of which has been completed, whether or not the
company has been removed from the Niue register;
(c) That has ceased to carry on business because of its inability to pay
its debts as and when they became due;
(d) In respect of which execution is returned unsatisfied in whole or in
part;
(e) In respect of the property of which a receiver, or a receiver and
manager, has been appointed by a Court or pursuant to the powers
contained in a document, whether or not the appointment has been
terminated;
(f) In respect of which, or the property of which, a person has been
appointed as a receiver and manager, or a judicial manager, or as a
manager, or to exercise control, under an enactment, whether or
not the appointment has been terminated;

Companies Act 2006

365
(g) That has entered into a compromise or arrangement with its creditors.

82 Court may prohibit persons from managing companies

(1) The Court may, on the application of the Registrar, make an order that
a person must not, without the leave of the Court, be a director or promoter of a
company, or in any way, whether directly or indirectly, be concerned in, or take
part in the management of, a company for any period, not exceeding 5 years, that
is specified in the order if –
(a) The person was, within a period of 5 years before a notice was given
to that person under section 83 (whether that period commenced
before or after the commencement of this Act), a director of, or
concerned in, or a person who took part in, the management of, a
company in relation to which this section applies; and
(b) The manner in which the affairs of the company were managed
was wholly or partly responsible for the company being a company
in relation to which this section applies; and
(c) The person bears a significant degree of responsibility for the
manner in which the affairs of the company were managed.
(2) If a person was, within a period of 5 years before a notice was given to
that person under section 83 (whether that period commenced before or after the
commencement of this Act), a director of, or concerned in, or a person who took
part in, the management of, 2 or more companies to which this section applies,
subsection (1)(b) and (c) are presumed to be satisfied in relation to each of those
companies unless that person satisfies the Court to the contrary.
(3) The Registrar must give public notice of the making of any order under
subsection (1).
(4) Every person who fails to comply with an order under this section
commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 7 years or to a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty units, or both.
(5) In this section and sections 83 and 84, company includes an overseas
company that carries on business in Niue.

83 Notice of application

(1) The Registrar must not make an application under section 82(1) unless –
(a) Not less than 10 working days’ notice of the fact that the Registrar
intends to consider making the application is given to the person
and the Registrar considers any representations made by the person;
and
(b) The Registrar appoints a suitably qualified accountant to advise
the Registrar in relation to the making of the application. That
accountant may also be appointed to inquire into the affairs of the
company under section 313; and
(c) The accountant appointed under paragraph (b), after considering
the information in the Registrar ’s possession, any representations
made by the person concerned to the Registrar, and if the accountant
thinks fit, any representations made by that person to the
accountant, advises the Registrar that, in his or her professional
opinion –
(i) the manner in which the affairs of the company were managed
was wholly or partly responsible for the company being a
company to which this section applies; and
366 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(ii) the person bears a significant degree of responsibility for the manner in which the affairs of the company were managed.
(2) If the Registrar has made an application under section 82(1) in respect of a person, the Registrar may give a notice to that person prohibiting that person from being a director or promoter of a company, or being concerned in, or taking part, whether directly or indirectly, in the management of, a company pending the determination by the Court of that application. The Registrar must give public notice of every such notice.
(3) No person to whom a notice under subsection (2) applies may be a
director or promoter of a company, or be concerned or take part (whether directly
or indirectly) in the management of a company.
(4) If a person to whom the Registrar has issued a notice under subsection
(2) appeals against the issue of the notice under this Act or otherwise seeks judicial
review of the notice, the notice remains in full force and effect pending the
determination of the appeal or review, as the case may be.
(5) The Registrar may, by notice in writing to a person to whom a notice
under subsection (2) has been given –
(a) Revoke that notice; or
(b) Exempt that person from the notice in relation to a specified
company or companies, on such conditions as the Registrar thinks
fit. The Registrar must give public notice of every such notice.
(6) Every person to whom a notice under subsection (2) is given who fails
to comply with the notice commits an offence and is liable on conviction to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years or to a fine not exceeding 1000
penalty units, or both.

84 Liability for contravening sections 77, 78, or 82

(1) A person who acts as a director of a company in contravention of section
77 or an order made under section 78 is, while that person was so acting, personally
liable to –
(a) A liquidator of the company for every unpaid debt incurred by the company; and
(b) A creditor of the company for a debt to that creditor incurred by the company.
(2) A person who acts in contravention of an order or a notice under section
82 is, while that person was so acting, personally liable to –
(a) A liquidator of the company for every unpaid debt incurred by the
company; and
(b) A creditor of the company for a debt to that creditor incurred by
the company.

Subpart 4 – Office of director

APPOINTMENT AND RETIREMENT OF DIRECTORS

85 Qualifications of directors

(1) A person may be appointed and hold office as a director of a company
only if the person –
(a) Is a natural person; and
(b) Is not disqualified from being a director under subsection (2).
(2) The following persons are disqualified from being a director of a
company –
(a) A person who is under 21 years of age;

Companies Act 2006

367
(b) A person who is an undischarged bankrupt;
(c) A person who is prohibited from being a director or promoter of,
or being concerned or taking part in the management of, a company
under sections 77, 78, or 82;
(d) A person in respect of whom a trustee order is in force under section
501 of the Niue Act 1966, or in respect of whom an order of medical
custody is in force under section 602 of that Act;
(e) In relation to any particular company, a person who does not comply
with any qualifications for directors contained in the rules of that
company.
(3) A person who is disqualified from being a director but who acts as a
director is treated as a director for the purposes of any provision of this Act that
imposes a duty or an obligation on a director of a company.

86 Appointment of directors

(1) A person named as a director in an application for registration or in an
amalgamation proposal holds office as a director from the date of registration or
the date the amalgamation proposal is effective, as the case may be, until that
person ceases to hold office as a director in accordance with this Act.
(2) All subsequent directors of a company may, unless the rules of the
company provide otherwise, be appointed by ordinary resolution.
(3) The appointment of a person as a director is not effective until that
person has consented in writing to act as a director of the company.

87 Director ceasing to hold office

(1) The office of director of a company is vacated if the person holding
that office –
(a) Resigns in accordance with subsection (2); or
(b) Is removed from office in accordance with subsection (4) or the rules
of the company; or
(c) Becomes disqualified from being a director under section 85(2); or
(d) Dies; or
(e) Otherwise vacates office in accordance with the rules of the
company.
(2) A director of a company may resign by signing a written notice of
resignation and delivering it to the registered office of the company.
(3) Subject to subsections (5) and (6), the notice is effective when it is
received at that address or at a later time specified in the notice.
(4) Subject to the company’s rules, a director may be removed by ordinary
resolution.
(5) If a company has only 1 director, that director may not resign office –
(a) Until that director has called a meeting of shareholders to receive
notice of the resignation; or
(b) If the company has only 1 shareholder, until that director has given
not less than 10 working days’ notice of the resignation to that
shareholder.
(6) A notice of resignation given by the sole director of a company does
not take effect, despite its terms, until the earlier of the appointment of another
director of the company or –
(a) The time and date for which a meeting of shareholders is called
under subsection (5)(a); or
368 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) If the company has only 1 shareholder, 10 working days after notice of the resignation has been given to that shareholder.
(7) Despite the vacation of office, a person who held office as a director remains liable under the provisions of this Act that impose liabilities on directors in relation to acts and omissions and decisions made while that person was a director.

88 Notice of change of directors

(1) A company must ensure that the following notices in the prescribed
form are delivered to the Registrar for registration –
(a) Notice of a change in the directors of a company, whether as the
result of a director ceasing to hold office or the appointment of a
new director, or both;
(b) Notice of a change in the name or the residential address or the
postal address of a director of a company.
(2) A notice under subsection (1) must –
(a) Specify the date of the change; and
(b) Include the full name and residential address and postal address of
every person who is a director of the company from the date of the
notice; and
(c) In the case of the appointment of a new director, have attached a
consent by that person to act as a director, in the prescribed form;
and
(d) be delivered to the Registrar within 20 working days of –
(i) the change occurring, in the case of the appointment or
resignation of a director; or
(ii) the company first becoming aware of the change, in the case of
the death of a director or a change in the name or residential
address or postal address of a director.
(3) If a company fails to comply with this section –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

Miscellaneous

89 Remuneration of directors

Directors may receive remuneration and other benefits from the company –
(a) In accordance with its rules; or
(b) With the approval of shareholders under section 51.

90 Proceedings of directors

(1) The rules of a company must include provisions –
(a) For holding meetings of directors of the company; and
(b) That govern proceedings at meetings of directors of the company.
(2) Meetings of the directors of a company must be held in accordance
with the rules of the company.

Companies Act 2006

369
PART 6
ENFORCEMENT

Injunctions

91 Injunctions to require compliance with Act and rules

(1) Without limiting section 16(2) or this Part, the Court may, on an
application under this section, make an order restraining a company that, or a
director of a company who, proposes to engage in conduct that would contravene
the rules of the company or this Act from engaging in that conduct.
(2) An application may be made by –
(a) The company; or
(b) A director or shareholder of the company.
(3) If the Court makes an order under subsection (1), it may also grant any
consequential relief that it thinks fit.
(4) An order may not be made under this section in relation to conduct or
a course of conduct that has been completed.
(5) The Court may, at any time before the final determination of an
application under subsection (1), make, as an interim order, any order that it is
empowered to make under that subsection.

Derivative actions

92 Leave to bring proceedings

Subject to section 95, the Court may, on the application of a person referred
to in section 93, grant leave to that person to –
(a) Bring proceedings in the name and on behalf of the company or
any subsidiary of the company; or
(b) Intervene in proceedings to which the company or any subsidiary
company is a party for the purpose of continuing, defending, or
discontinuing the proceedings on behalf of the company or
subsidiary, as the case may be.

93 Who may apply for leave to bring proceedings

An application for leave to bring proceedings or to intervene in proceedings
under section 92 may be made by –
(a) A director of the company; or
(b) A shareholder or shareholders representing not less than 10% of
the voting rights of all shareholders entitled to vote on a resolution
to amend the rules of the company.

94 Matters that Court must consider

Without limiting section 92, in determining whether to grant leave under
that section, the Court must consider –
(a) The likelihood of the proceedings succeeding; and
(b) The costs of the proceedings in relation to the relief likely to be
obtained; and
(c) Any action already taken by the company or subsidiary to obtain
relief; and
(d) The interests of the company or subsidiary in the proceedings being
commenced, continued, defended, or discontinued, as the case may
be.
370 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

95 When leave may be granted

Leave to bring proceedings or intervene in proceedings may be granted
only if the Court is satisfied that either –
(a) The company or subsidiary does not intend to bring, diligently
continue or defend, or discontinue the proceedings, as the case may
be; or
(b) It is in the interests of the company or subsidiary that the conduct
of the proceedings should not be left to the directors or to the
determination of the shareholders as a whole.

96 Procedural matters

(1) Notice of the application must be served on the company or subsidiary.
(2) The company or subsidiary –
(a) Must inform the Court whether or not it intends to bring, continue,
defend, or discontinue the proceedings, as the case may be; and
(b) May appear and be heard.
(3) Except as otherwise provided, a shareholder is not entitled to bring or
intervene in any proceedings in the name of, or on behalf of, a company or its
subsidiaries.
(4) No proceedings brought or intervened in with leave of the Court may
be settled or compromised or discontinued without the approval of the Court.

97 Powers of Court

The Court may, at any time, make any order that it thinks fit in relation to
proceedings brought or intervened in with leave of the Court and, without
limitation, may –
(a) Make an order authorising the person to whom leave was granted
or any other person to control the conduct of the proceedings;
(b) Give directions for the conduct of the proceedings;
(c) Make an order requiring the company or the directors to provide
information or assistance in relation to the proceedings;
(d) Make an order directing that any amount ordered to be paid by a
defendant in the proceedings must be paid, in whole or part, to
former and present shareholders of the company or subsidiary
instead of to the company or the subsidiary.

98 Costs of derivative action to be met by company

The Court must, on the application of the person to whom leave was
granted, order that the reasonable costs of bringing or intervening in the
proceedings, including any costs relating to any settlement, compromise, or
discontinuance approved by the Court, must be met by the company unless the
Court considers that it would be unjust or inequitable for the company to bear
those costs, or to bear the whole of those costs.

Personal actions by shareholders

99 Personal actions by shareholders against company

(1) A shareholder of a company may bring an action against the company
for breach of a duty owed by the company to him or her as a shareholder.
(2) The Court may, on the application of a shareholder of a company, if it is
satisfied that it is just and equitable to do so, make an order requiring the company
to take any action that is required to be taken by the rules of the company or this
Act, whether or not the company owes a duty to the shareholder to take that
action.

Companies Act 2006

371
(3) On making an order under this section, the Court may grant any consequential relief that it thinks fit.

100 Personal actions by shareholders against directors

(1) A shareholder or former shareholder may bring an action against a
director for breach of a duty owed to him or her as a shareholder.
(2) An action may not be brought under subsection (1) to recover any loss
in the form of a reduction in the value of shares in the company or a failure of the
shares to increase in value by reason only of a loss suffered, or a gain forgone, by
the company.
(3) The Court may, on the application of a shareholder of a company, if it is
satisfied that it is just and equitable to do so, make an order requiring a director of
the company to take any action that is required to be taken by the directors under
the rules of the company or this Act, whether or not the director owes a duty to
the shareholder to take that action.
(4) On making an order under this section, the Court may grant any
consequential relief that it thinks fit.

101 Representative actions

(1) The Court may appoint a shareholder of a company to represent all or
some of the shareholders having the same or substantially the same interest if –
(a) The shareholder brings proceedings against the company or a
director; and
(b) Other shareholders have the same, or substantially the same, interest
in relation to the subject matter of the proceedings.
(2) On making an order under subsection (1), the Court may, for that
purpose, make any other order that it thinks fit, including an order –
(a) As to the control and conduct of the proceedings;
(b) As to the costs of the proceedings;
(c) Directing the distribution of any amount ordered to be paid by a
defendant in the proceedings among the shareholders represented.

Prejudiced shareholders

102 Prejudiced shareholders

(1) A shareholder or former shareholder of a company may apply to the
Court for an order under subsection (2) if the shareholder considers that the affairs
of a company have been, or are being, or are likely to be, conducted in a manner
that is, or any act or acts of the company have been, or are, or are likely to be,
oppressive, unfairly discriminatory, or unfairly prejudicial to him or her in that
capacity or in any other capacity.
(2) If the Court considers that it is just and equitable to do so, it may make
any order that it thinks fit, including an order –
(a) Requiring the company or any other person to acquire the
shareholder ’s shares; or
(b) Requiring the company or any other person to pay compensation
to a person; or
(c) Regulating the future conduct of the company’s affairs; or
(d) Altering or adding to the company’s rules; or
(e) Appointing a receiver of the company; or
(f) Directing the rectification of the records of the company; or
(g) Putting the company into liquidation; or
(h) Setting aside action taken by the company or the board in breach of
this Act or the rules of the company.
372 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) No order may be made against the company or any other person under subsection (2) unless the company or that person is a party to the proceedings in which the application is made.

103 Certain conduct deemed prejudicial

Failure to comply with any of the following sections of this Act is conduct
that is deemed to be unfairly prejudicial for the purposes of section 102 –
(a) Section 26(1) (which relates to the issue of shares);
(b) Section 30 (which relates to dividends);
(c) Section 31 (which relates to acquisitions of its own shares by a
company);
(d) Section 34 (which relates to redeemable shares);
(e) Section 36 (which relates to the provision of financial assistance by
a company to purchase its own shares);
(f) Section 50 (which relates to major transactions);
(g) Section 54 (which relates to the alteration of shareholder rights).

104 Alteration to rules by Court

(1) Despite anything in this Act, but subject to the order, if the Court makes
an order under section 102 altering or adding to the rules of a company, the rules
must not, to the extent that they have been altered or added to by the Court, again
be altered or added to without the leave of the Court.
(2) Any alteration or addition to the rules of a company made by an order
under section 102 has the same effect as if it had been made by the shareholders of
the company under section 14, and this Act applies to the rules as altered or added
to.
(3) Within 10 working days of the making of an order under section 102 altering or adding to the rules of a company, the company must ensure that a copy of the order and a copy of the rules as altered or added to are delivered to the Registrar for registration.
(4) If a company fails to comply with subsection (3) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

Certain applications

105 Effect of arbitration clause in rules

A shareholder is entitled to apply to the Court for relief under sections 91
to 100 and 102 despite any provision in the rules of a company requiring disputes
relating to the affairs of the company to be referred to arbitration, or otherwise
seeking to prohibit the shareholder from making the application.

106 Application for relief by Registrar

(1) The Registrar may apply to the Court for an order in respect of a public
company under sections 91 to 100 and 102 as if the Registrar were a shareholder
of that company if –
(a) The Registrar is requested to do so in writing by a shareholder or
shareholders who would be entitled to make the application in
question; and
(b) The Registrar considers that it is in the public interest that the
application be made; and

Companies Act 2006

373
(c) The Registrar considers that it is unreasonable to expect the person or persons making the request to pursue the application themselves.
(2) If the Registrar considers that the persons making a request under subsection (1) should bear some of the costs of any application to be made by the Registrar under this section, the Registrar may require them to pay an amount towards those costs, or to enter into an agreement to contribute to those costs. If they fail to do so, the Registrar may decline to make the application, or to take any further steps in relation to the application.
(3) If an application made by the Registrar under this section results in an
award of costs or any other monetary award in favour of the Registrar or the
company or the shareholders of the company, the Registrar has a first claim on
that award for payment of the costs incurred by the Registrar in making the
application.
PART 7
ADMINISTRATION OF COMPANIES

Subpart 1 – Dealings with third parties

BINDING COMPANY

107 Authority to bind company

(1) A contract or other enforceable obligation may be entered into by a
company as follows –
(a) An obligation that, if entered into by a natural person, would, by
law, be required to be by deed, may be entered into on behalf of the
company in writing signed under the name of the company by –
(i) 2 or more directors of the company; or
(ii) if there is only 1 director, by that director, whose signature must
be witnessed; or
(iii) if the rules of the company so provide, a director, or other person
or class of persons. If the rules provide for signature by 1 person,
that person’s signature must be witnessed; or
(iv) 1 or more attorneys appointed by the company in accordance
with section 108;
(b) An obligation that, if entered into by a natural person, is, by law,
required to be in writing, may be entered into on behalf of the
company –
(i) in the manner specified in paragraph (a); or
(ii) in writing by a person acting under the company’s express or
implied authority;
(c) An obligation that, if entered into by a natural person, is not, by
law, required to be in writing, may be entered into on behalf of the
company by a person acting under the company’s express or
implied authority.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) prevents a company from affixing its common
seal to a contract or document, if it has one. But despite anything in the rules of
the company, the absence of a seal does not affect the enforceability of an obligation
entered into in accordance with subsection (1).
(3) Subsection (1) applies to a contract or other obligation whether or not –
(a) That contract or obligation was entered into in Niue; and
(b) The law governing the contract or obligation is the law of Niue.
374 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

108 Attorneys

(1) Subject to its rules, a company may, by an instrument in writing executed
in accordance with section 107(1)(a), appoint a person as its attorney either
generally or in relation to a specified matter.
(2) An act of the attorney in accordance with the instrument binds the
company.
(3) Part XII of the Property Law Act 1952 applies, with the necessary
modifications, in relation to a power of attorney executed by a company to the
same extent as if the company was a natural person and as if the commencement
of the liquidation or, if there is no liquidation, the removal from the Niue register,
of the company was the death of a person within the meaning of that Part.

109 Validity of dealings with third parties

(1) Subject to sections 111 and 112, the validity of a transaction entered
into by a company is not affected by –
(a) A failure to comply with this Act (except section 107);
(b) A failure to comply with the company’s rules;
(c) The absence of express authority to enter into the transaction in the
company’s rules;
(d) A failure by the company or its directors to take any steps required
by the company’s rules to authorise entry into the transaction;
(e) The fact that the transaction is not in the interests of the company;
(f) A breach of duty by a director in connection with entry into the
transaction.
(2) Subsection (1) does not limit –
(a) Section 91 (which relates to injunctions to restrain conduct by a
company that would contravene its rules); or
(b) Sections 92 to 98 (which relate to derivative actions); or
(c) Section 99 (which relates to actions by shareholders against a
company); or
(d) Section 100 (which relates to actions by shareholders against
directors); or
(e) The obligations and the liabilities of directors of a company in
respect of any contract or other obligation, or transfer of property
to or by the company.
(3) In this section and sections 111 to 113, transaction –
(a) Includes any contract or other obligation entered into by a company,
or any transfer of property to or by a company; but
(b) Does not include –
(i) A distribution to shareholders; or
(ii) An indemnity provided to a director under section 75; or
(iii) remuneration or other benefits given to a director in accordance
with section 89.

110 Assumptions that may be made by third parties

(1) Without limiting section 109, neither a company nor any person
claiming under or through a company, nor a guarantor of an obligation of a
company, may assert against a person dealing with the company or against a person
who has acquired property, rights, or interests from the company that –
(a) A person named as a director of the company in the most recent
notice received by the Registrar under section 88 or in the most
recent annual return delivered to the Registrar –

Companies Act 2006

375
(i) is not a director of a company; or
(ii) has not been duly appointed; or
(iii) does not have authority to exercise a power that a director of a
company carrying on business of the kind carried on by the
company customarily has authority to exercise;
(b) A person held out by the company as a director, employee, or agent
of the company –
(i) has not been duly appointed; or
(ii) does not have authority to exercise a power that a director,
employee, or agent of a company carrying on business of the
kind carried on by the company customarily has authority to
exercise;
(c) A person held out by the company as a director, employee, or agent
of the company with authority to exercise a power that a director,
employee, or agent of a company carrying on business of the kind
carried on by the company does not customarily have authority to
exercise, does not have authority to exercise that power;
(d) A document issued on behalf of a company by a director, employee,
or agent of the company with actual or usual authority to issue the
document is not valid or not genuine –
unless the person has, or ought to have by virtue of his or her position with or
relationship to the company, knowledge of the matters referred to in any of
paragraphs (a) to (d).
(2) Subsection (1) applies even though a person of the kind referred to in
that subsection acts fraudulently or forges a document that appears to have been
signed on behalf of the company, unless the person dealing with the company or
with a person who has acquired property, rights, or interests from the company
has actual knowledge of the fraud or forgery.
(3) A person is not affected by, or deemed to have notice or knowledge of
the contents of, the rules of, or any other document relating to, a company merely
because the rules or document are –
(a) Registered on the Niue register; or
(b) Available for inspection by that person under subpart 2.

111 Transactions in which directors are interested

(1) A transaction entered into by a company in which a director is directly
or indirectly materially interested is voidable at the option of the company, unless –
(a) This Act or the company’s rules expressly authorise entry into the
transaction despite such an interest; or
(b) The transaction has been entered into with the approval of
shareholders under section 51 following disclosure of the nature
and extent of the director ’s interest to all shareholders who were
not otherwise aware of those matters; or
(c) The other party to the transaction is a person other than the director
or a person associated with the director and either –
(i) that person did not know of the interest of the director; or
(ii) the company received fair value under the transaction.
(2) For the purposes of this section and section 112, a person is associated
with a director if the director –
(a) Is the parent, child, or spouse of that person; or
(b) Is a director, employee, or trustee of that person; or
(c) Has a material financial interest in that other person.
376 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

112 Transactions entered into by directors in breach of certain duties

A transaction entered into by a company as the result of action taken by a
director in breach of sections 65, 66, or 67 is voidable at the option of the company
if –
(a) The other party to the transaction is the director or a person associated with the director; or
(b) The other party to the transaction is a person with knowledge of the circumstances giving rise to the breach of sections 65, 66, or 67, and the company did not receive fair value under the transaction.

113 Effect on third parties

The setting aside of a transaction under sections 111 or 112 does not affect
the title or interest of a person in or to property that the person has acquired if the
property was acquired –
(a) From a person other than the company; and
(b) For valuable consideration; and
(c) Without knowledge of the circumstances that entitle the company
to set aside the transaction under which the property was acquired
from the company.

Pre-incorporation contracts

114 Pre-incorporation contracts may be ratified

(1) In this section and in sections 115 and 116, pre-incorporation contract
means –
(a) A contract purporting to be made by a company before its incorporation; or
(b) A contract made by a person on behalf of a company before, and in
contemplation of, its incorporation.
(2) Despite any enactment or rule of law, a pre-incorporation contract may
be ratified by the company within any period that may be specified in the contract,
or if no period is specified, within a reasonable time after the incorporation of the
company in the name of which, or on behalf of which, it has been made.
(3) A pre-incorporation contract that is ratified is as valid and enforceable
as if the company had been a party to the contract when it was made.
(4) A pre-incorporation contract may be ratified by a company in the same
manner as a contract may be entered into on behalf of a company under section
107.
(5) Despite any other Act, if a pre-incorporation contract has not been ratified by a company, or validated by the Court under section 116, the company may not enforce it or take the benefit of it.

115 Warranties implied in pre-incorporation contracts

(1) Despite any enactment or rule of law, in a pre-incorporation contract,
unless a contrary intention is expressed in the contract, there is an implied warranty
by the person who purports to make the contract in the name of, or on behalf of,
the company –
(a) That the company will be incorporated within the period specified
in the contract or, if no period is specified, within a reasonable time
after the making of the contract; and
(b) That the company will ratify the contract within the period specified
in the contract or, if no period is specified, within a reasonable time
after the incorporation of the company.

Companies Act 2006

377
(2) The amount of damages recoverable in an action for breach of a warranty implied by subsection (1) is the same as the amount of damages that would be recoverable in an action against the company for damages for breach by the company of any unperformed obligations under the contract if the contract had been ratified.
(3) If, after its incorporation, a company enters into a contract in the same
terms as, or in substitution for, a pre-incorporation contract (not being a contract
ratified by the company under section 114), the liability of a person under
subsection (1) (including any liability under an order made by the Court for the
payment of damages) is discharged unless a contrary intention is expressed in the
pre-incorporation contract.

116 Failure to ratify

(1) A party to a pre-incorporation contract that has not been ratified by the
company after its incorporation may apply to the Court for an order –
(a) Directing the company to return to that party property of any kind
acquired by the company from that party by virtue of the contract;
or
(b) For any other relief in favour of that party relating to the property.
(2) The Court may, if it considers it just and equitable to do so, make any
order or grant any relief that it thinks fit and may do so whether or not an order
has been made under section 115(2).

117 Company records

Subpart 2 – Company records

(1) Subject to section 119, a company must keep the following documents at its registered office –
(a) The rules of the company;
(b) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of shareholders within the
last 7 years;
(c) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of directors and directors’
committees within the last 7 years;
(d) The full names and residential and postal addresses of the current
directors;
(e) Copies of all written communications to all shareholders or all
holders of the same class of shares during the last 7 years, including
annual reports;
(f) The accounting records required by section 129 for the current
accounting period and for the last 7 completed accounting periods
of the company;
(g) Copies of all financial statements required to be completed under
section 130 for the last 7 completed accounting periods of the
company;
(h) The share register.
(2) The references in subsection (1)(b), (c), and (e) to 7 years and the
references in subsection (1)(f) and (g) to 7 completed accounting periods include
any lesser periods that the Registrar may approve by notice in writing to the
company.
(3) If a company fails to comply with subsection (1) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
378 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

118 Form of records

(1) The records of a company must be kept –
(a) In written form; or
(b) In a form or in a manner that allows the records to be readily
accessible so as to be usable for subsequent reference, and
convertible into written form.
(2) The directors must ensure that adequate measures exist to –
(a) Prevent the records being falsified; and
(b) Detect any falsification of them.
(3) If the directors fail to comply with subsection (2), every director commits
an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

119 Alternative locations of records

(1) The records referred to in section 117(1)(a) to (g) may be kept at a place
in Niue other than the company’s registered office, provided that notice of that
place is given to the Registrar in accordance with subsection (7).
(2) The share register may, if expressly permitted by the rules, be divided
into 2 or more registers kept in different places.
(3) The principal register must be kept in Niue. Any other share register
may be kept at a place outside Niue.
(4) If a share register is divided into 2 or more registers kept in different
places –
(a) Notice of the place where each register is kept must be delivered to the Registrar in accordance with subsection (7) within 10 working days after the share register is divided or any place where a register is kept is altered; and
(b) A copy of every register must be kept at the same place as the principal register; and
(c) If an entry is made in a register other than the principal register, a corresponding entry must be made within 10 working days in the copy of that register kept with the principal register.
(5) In this section, principal register, in relation to a company, means –
(a) If the share register is not divided into 2 or more registers, the share
register; or
(b) If the share register is divided into 2 or more registers, the register
described as the principal register in the last notice sent to the
Registrar under this section.
(6) A company need not keep its accounting records in Niue, but if the
records are not kept in Niue –
(a) The company must ensure that accounts and returns for the
operations of the company that –
(i) disclose with reasonable accuracy the financial position of the
company at intervals not exceeding 6 months; and
(ii) will enable the preparation in accordance with this Act of the
company’s financial statements and any other document
required by this Act –
are sent to, and kept at, a place in Niue; and

Companies Act 2006

379
(b) Notice of the place where –
(i) The accounting records; and
(ii) the accounts and returns required under paragraph (a) –
are kept must be given to the Registrar in accordance with subsection (7).
(7) If any records are not kept at the registered office of the company, or
the place at which they are kept is changed, the company must ensure that within
10 working days of their first being kept elsewhere or moved, as the case may be,
notice is given to the Registrar of the places where the records are kept.
(8) If a company fails to comply with subsections (3), (4), (6), or (7) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

120 Inspection of records by directors

(1) Subject to subsection (2), every director of a company is entitled, on
giving reasonable notice, to inspect the records of the company –
(a) In written form; and
(b) Without charge; and
(c) At a reasonable time specified by the director.
(2) The Court may, on application by the company, direct that the records
need not be made available for inspection or limit the inspection of them in any
manner it thinks fit if it is satisfied that –
(a) It would not be in the company’s interests for a director to inspect
the records; or
(b) The proposed inspection is for a purpose that is not properly
connected with the director ’s duties.

121 Inspection of records by shareholders

(1) A company must keep the following records available for inspection in
the manner prescribed in section 123 by a shareholder of the company, or by a
person authorised in writing by a shareholder for the purpose, who serves written
notice of intention to inspect on the company –
(a) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of shareholders;
(b) Copies of written communications to all shareholders or to all
holders of a class of shares during the preceding 7 years, including
annual reports and financial statements;
(c) The records that must be available for public inspection under
section 122.
(2) If a company fails to comply with subsection (1) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

122 Inspection of records by public

(1) A company must keep the following records available for inspection in
the manner prescribed in section 123 by any person who serves written notice of
intention to inspect on the company –
(a) The certificate of incorporation or registration of the company;
(b) The rules of the company, if they differ from the model rules;
(c) The share register;
380 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) The full names and residential addresses of the directors;
(e) Details of the registered office of the company and of its postal
address, if different from the registered office;
(f) Details of any place other than the registered office at which records
are kept in accordance with section 119.
(2) If a company fails to comply with subsection (1) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

123 Manner of inspection

(1) Documents that may be inspected under sections 121 or 122 must be
available for inspection at the place at which the company’s records are kept
between the hours of 9.00 am and 4.00 pm on each working day during the
inspection period.
(2) In this section, inspection period means the period commencing on the
third working day after the day on which notice of intention to inspect is served
on the company by the person or shareholder concerned and ending with the
eighth working day after the day of service.
(3) A person may require a copy of, or extract from, a document that is
available for inspection by him or her under sections 121 or 122 to be sent to him
or her –
(a) Within 5 working days after he or she has made a request in writing for the copy or extract; and
(b) If he or she has paid a reasonable copying and administration fee prescribed by the company.
(4) If a company fails to provide a copy of, or extract from, a document in accordance with a request under subsection (3) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

Subpart 3 – Documents to be sent to Registrar and shareholders

124 Annual returns

(1) The directors of a company must ensure that there is delivered to the
Registrar each year, for registration, during the month allocated to the company
for the purpose, an annual return –
(a) In the prescribed form or in a form approved by the Registrar by
public notice or in a form approved by the Registrar for use by the
company under subsection (8), or as near to it as circumstances
allow; and
(b) Containing the prescribed information or the information approved
by the Registrar by public notice; and
(c) Accompanied by the prescribed annual return fee.
(2) The annual return must be dated as at a day within the month during
which the return is required to be delivered to the Registrar, and the information
required to be contained in it must be compiled as at that date.
(3) The annual return must be signed by a director of the company or by a
solicitor or public accountant authorised for that purpose.

Companies Act 2006

381
(4) On registration of a company under Part 2 or reregistration under Part
14, the Registrar must allocate a month to the company for the purposes of this
section.
(5) The Registrar may, by written notice to a company, alter the month
allocated to the company under subsection (4).
(6) Despite subsection (1) –
(a) A company need not make an annual return in the calendar year of
its incorporation; and
(b) A subsidiary may, with the written approval of the Registrar, make
an annual return during the month allocated to its holding company
instead of during the month allocated to it.
(7) Different forms of annual return may be prescribed or approved by the
Registrar by public notice in respect of different classes of companies.
(8) The Registrar may, on the application of any person, approve the use,
by such company or companies as the Registrar may specify, of a form of annual
return different from that prescribed or approved by the Registrar by public notice,
and may at any time revoke, in whole or in part, that approval.
(9) If the directors of a company fail to comply with subsections (1) or (2),
every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

125 Registrar may send annual return form to company

(1) The Registrar may send to a company an annual return form that sets
out the prescribed information as it appears on the Niue register –
(a) For approval in accordance with section 124(3) if the information
set out in the form is current as at a date in the month in which the
return is required to be made; or
(b) For such correction as may be required, and approval of the
corrected information in accordance with section 124(3).
(2) If the annual return contains –
(a) An address of the registered office of the company; or
(b) A postal address of the company –
that is different from the address of the registered office or the postal address of
the company entered on the Niue register, the Registrar may alter the Niue register
accordingly.

126 Other documents to be sent to Registrar

In addition to the annual return required under section 124, a company
must send the following documents to the Registrar under this Act –
(a) Notice of the adoption of new rules by a company, or the alteration
of the rules of a company, under section 14;
(b) Notice of a change in the registered office or postal address of the
company under section 18;
(c) Notice of the issue of shares by the company, under section 26;
(d) Notice of the acquisition by the company of its own shares under
section 31;
(e) Notice of the redemption of a share under section 35;
(f) Notice of a change in the directors of the company, or of a change
in the name or residential address of a director, under section 88;
(g) Notice of the making of an order under section 102 altering or
adding to the rules of a company;
382 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(h) Notice of any place other than the registered office of the company where records are kept, or of any change in the place where records are kept, under section 119;
(i) documents requested by the Registrar under section 311.

127 Annual report to shareholders

An annual report must be sent to shareholders in accordance with section
56.

128 Other documents to be sent to shareholders

In addition to any annual report required under section 56, a company
must send the following documents to shareholders –
(a) Notice of any repurchase of shares to which section 31(4) applies;
(b) Notice of a written resolution approved under section 52;
(c) Financial statements required to be sent under section 130;
(d) A written statement by an auditor under section 136;
(e) A report by an auditor under section 138.

Subpart 4 – Accounting and audit

129 Accounting records to be kept

(1) The directors of a company must ensure accounting records are kept
that –
(a) Correctly record and explain the transactions of the company; and
(b) Will at any time enable the financial position of the company to be
determined with reasonable accuracy; and
(c) Will enable the directors to ensure that the financial statements of
the company comply with section 130 and with any regulations
made under this Act; and
(d) Will enable the financial statements of the company to be readily
and properly audited.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), the accounting records must contain –
(a) Entries of money received and spent each day and the matters to
which it relates; and
(b) A record of the assets and liabilities of the company; and
(c) If the company’s business involves dealing in goods –
(i) a record of goods bought and sold, and relevant invoices; and
(ii) a record of stock held at the end of the financial year together
with records of any stocktakings during the year; and
(d) If the company’s business involves providing services, a record of
services provided and relevant invoices.
(3) If a company sells goods or provides services for cash in the ordinary
course of carrying on a retail business –
(a) Invoices need not be kept in respect of each retail transaction for
the purposes of subsection (2); and
(b) A record of the total money received each day in respect of the sale
of goods or provision of services, as the case may be, is sufficient to
comply with subsection (2) in respect of those transactions.
(4) The accounting records must be kept –
(a) In a form permitted under section 118; and
(b) At the registered office of the company, or any other place permitted
under section 119.

Companies Act 2006

383
(5) If the directors of a company fail to comply with the requirements of this section, every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

130 Financial statements to be prepared

(1) The directors of every company must ensure that –
(a) Within 4 months after the balance date of the company, or within
any extended period applicable under subsection (3), financial
statements that comply with subsection (2) are completed in relation
to the company and that balance date; and
(b) Within 20 working days of the date on which the financial
statements must be completed under paragraph (a), those financial
statements are sent to all shareholders. This requirement may be
satisfied by sending the financial statements to shareholders in an
annual report in accordance with section 56.
(2) The financial statements of a company must –
(a) Give a true and fair view of the matters to which they relate; and
(b) Comply with any applicable regulations made under this Act; and
(c) be dated and signed on behalf of the directors by 2 directors of the
company or, if the company has only 1 director, by that director.
(3) The period within which a private company must comply with the
requirements of subsection (1)(a) may be extended by special resolution to a period
not greater than 7 months.
(4) The following periods must not exceed 15 months –
(a) The period between the date of incorporation of a company and its
first balance date;
(b) The period between any 2 balance dates of a company.
(5) If the directors of a company fail to comply with subsection (1), every
director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine
not exceeding 50 penalty units.

131 Application

(1) This section and sections 132 to 134 apply to a company in respect of an
accounting period if –
(a) It is registered as a public company at any time during that
accounting period; or
(b) The company’s rules require it to appoint an auditor in respect of
that accounting period; or
(c) A shareholder or shareholders holding shares that together carry
the right to receive more than 20% of distributions made by the
company give written notice to the company before the end of the
accounting period requiring the financial statements of the company
for that period to be audited.
(2) If this section and sections 132 to 134 apply to a company in respect of
an accounting period, but do not apply in respect of a subsequent accounting
period –
(a) The financial statements of the company for the accounting period in respect of which this section applies must be audited; and
(b) The directors may give notice to all shareholders within 4 months of the commencement of a subsequent accounting period that this section and sections 132 to 134 no longer apply to the company, and that the auditor will cease to hold office unless a notice is given
384 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
by shareholders under subsection (1)(c) by a date specified in the notice, which must be not less than 30 working days from the date on which the notice is given; and
(c) If a notice has been given under paragraph (b), and no notice under subsection (1)(c) is received by the company by the date specified in that notice, the auditor ceases to hold office on the later of –
(i) The date specified in the notice; or
(ii) the date on which the audit of the financial statements of the
company for the previous accounting period is completed.

132 Appointment of auditor

(1) A company to which this section applies must appoint an auditor –
(a) To hold office as auditor until the auditor ceases to hold office under
section 133; and
(b) To audit the financial statements of the company.
(2) A company must appoint an auditor –
(a) Within 30 working days of the date on which this section first applies
to the company;
(b) Within 30 working days of any vacancy arising in the office of
auditor.

133 When auditor ceases to hold office

An auditor ceases to hold office if he or she –
(a) Ceases to hold office under section 131(2); or
(b) Resigns by delivering a written notice of resignation to the registered
office of the company not less than 20 working days before the date
on which the notice is expressed to be effective; or
(c) becomes disqualified from being the auditor of the company under
section 135; or
(d) Is replaced as auditor by an ordinary resolution appointing another
person as auditor in his or her place, following notice to the auditor
in accordance with section 136(2); or
(e) Dies; or
(f) becomes subject to a trustee order under section 501 of the Niue
Act 1966, or an order of medical custody under section 602 of that
Act.

134 Registrar may appoint auditor on request of shareholder

(1) The Registrar may, at the request of any shareholder, appoint an auditor
if –
(a) This section applies to a company; and
(b) The company has neglected or failed to appoint an auditor.
(2) If the Registrar appoints an auditor, the Registrar may determine the
fees to be paid by the company to the auditor.
(3) Any fees determined by the Registrar may be recovered as if they were
provided for in a contract between the company and the auditor.

Companies Act 2006

385

135 Qualifications of auditor

(1) A person must not be appointed or act as an auditor of a company
unless –
(a) The person is entitled to practise as an accountant in Niue, and meets any further requirements in respect of practice as an auditor in Niue that may be prescribed by regulations made under this Act; or
(b) If the audit is to be carried out outside Niue, the person is eligible to act as an auditor in the country, state, or territory in which the audit is to be carried out, and –
(i) The person is a member, fellow, or associate of an association of accountants constituted outside Niue that has been approved for the time being for the purposes of this section by the Registrar by public notice; or
(ii) the person has been approved for the time being for the
purposes of this section by the Registrar by public notice.
(2) The following persons must not be appointed or act as auditor of a
company –
(a) A director or secretary or employee of the company, or any other
person responsible for keeping the accounting records of the
company;
(b) A person who is a partner, or in the employment, of a person referred
to in paragraph (a);
(c) A liquidator or administrator or a person who is a receiver in respect
of the property of the company;
(d) A corporation;
(e) A person who, by virtue of any of paragraphs (a) to (c), may not be
appointed or act as auditor of a related company.

136 Statement by auditor in relation to resignation or removal

(1) If an auditor resigns from office, the directors must, if requested to do
so by that auditor –
(a) Distribute to all shareholders, at the expense of the company, a
written statement of the auditor ’s reasons for resigning; or
(b) Permit the auditor or his or her representative to explain at a
shareholders’ meeting the reasons for the resignation.
(2) A company must not appoint a new auditor in the place of an auditor
who is qualified to hold that office, unless –
(a) At least 20 working days’ written notice of a proposal to do so has
been given to the auditor; and
(b) The auditor has been given a reasonable opportunity to make
representations to the shareholders on the appointment of another
person either in writing or by the auditor or his or her representative
speaking at a shareholders’ meeting (whichever the auditor may
choose).
(3) An auditor is entitled to be paid reasonable fees and expenses by the
company for making the representations to shareholders referred to in subsections
(1) or (2).
386 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

137 Auditor to avoid conflict of interest

An auditor of a company must ensure, in carrying out the duties of an
auditor under this Part, that his or her judgment is not impaired by reason of any
relationship with, or interest in, the company or any related company.

138 Auditor’s report

The auditor of a company to which sections 131 to 134 apply must make a
report to the shareholders on the financial statements audited by him or her that
states –
(a) The work done by the auditor; and
(b) The scope and limitations of the audit; and
(c) The existence of any relationship (other than that of auditor) that
the auditor has with, or any interests that the auditor has in, the
company or any related company; and
(d) Whether the auditor has obtained all information and explanations
that he or she has required; and
(e) Whether, in the auditor ’s opinion, as far as appears from an
examination of them, proper accounting records have been kept by
the company; and
(f) Whether, in the auditor ’s opinion and having regard to any
information or explanations that may have been added by the
company, the financial statements –
(i) give a true and fair view of the matters to which they relate;
and
(ii) Comply with any applicable regulations made under this Act –
and, if they do not, the respects in which they fail to give such a
view or comply with such requirements, as the case may be; and
(g) Any other matter prescribed for the purposes of this section by
regulations made under this Act.

139 Access to information

(1) The directors of a company must ensure that an auditor of the company
has access at all times to the accounting records and other documents of the
company.
(2) An auditor of a company is entitled to require from a director or
employee of the company such information and explanations that he or she thinks
necessary for the performance of his or her duties as auditor.
(3) If the directors of a company fail to comply with subsection (1), every
director commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50
penalty units.
(4) A director or employee who fails to comply with subsection (2) commits
an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.
(5) It is a defence to an employee charged with an offence against subsection
(4) if the employee proves that –
(a) He or she did not have the information required in his or her
possession or under his or her control; or
(b) by reason of the position occupied by him or her or the duties
assigned to him or her, he or she was unable to give the explanations
required.

Companies Act 2006

387

140 Auditor’s attendance at shareholders’ meeting

(1) The directors of a company must ensure that an auditor of the
company –
(a) Is permitted to attend a meeting of shareholders of the company;
and
(b) Receives the notices and communications that a shareholder is
entitled to receive relating to meetings and resolutions of
shareholders; and
(c) May be heard at a meeting of shareholders that he or she attends
on any part of the business of the meeting that concerns him or her
as auditor.
(2) If the directors of a company fail to comply with subsection (1), every
director of the company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine
not exceeding 50 penalty units.

Subpart 5 – Company charges

141 Charges may be registered

(1) A registrable charge may be, but is not required to be, registered under
this Act in accordance with Schedule 7.
(2) Where any property of a company is subject to a registered charge and
an unregistered registrable charge, the registered charge has priority unless the
person entitled to the benefit of the registered charge –
(a) Has agreed otherwise; or
(b) Had notice at the time that the registered charge was granted that
the unregistered charge existed, and applied to the relevant property
or class of property.
(3) Where any property of a company is subject to more than 1 registered
company charge, those charges rank among themselves according to the date of
registration, unless the person entitled to the benefit of one registered company
charge (the first registered charge) that was registered before another company
charge (the second registered charge) –
(a) Has agreed to accept a lesser priority than this provision would
otherwise confer; or
(b) Had notice at the time that the first registered charge was granted
that the second registered charge existed, and that it applied to the
relevant property or class of property.

142 Amalgamations

PART 8
AMALGAMATIONS, ETC

Subpart 1 – Amalgamations

Two or more companies may amalgamate, and continue as 1 company, in accordance with this subpart.

143 Notice of proposed amalgamation

The directors of each amalgamating company must, not less than 20 working
days before the amalgamation is proposed to take effect –
(a) Send a copy of the amalgamation proposal to every secured creditor
of the company; and
(b) Give public notice of the proposed amalgamation, including a
statement that –
388 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(i) copies of the amalgamation proposal are available for inspection by any shareholder or creditor of an amalgamating company or any person to whom an amalgamating company is under an obligation at the registered offices of the amalgamating companies and at any other places specified during normal business hours; and
(ii) a shareholder or creditor of an amalgamating company or any person to whom an amalgamating company is under an obligation is entitled to be supplied free of charge with a copy of the amalgamation proposal on request to an amalgamating company.

144 Registration of amalgamation proposal

For the purpose of effecting an amalgamation, the following documents
must be delivered to the Registrar for registration –
(a) An amalgamation proposal approved in accordance with Schedule
6;
(b) A certificate signed by the directors of each amalgamating company
stating that the amalgamation has been approved in accordance
with this Act and the company’s rules;
(c) A document in the prescribed form signed by each of the persons
named in the amalgamation proposal as a director of the
amalgamated company containing his or her consent to be a director.

145 Certificate of amalgamation

(1) Immediately after receipt of the documents required under section 144,
the Registrar must issue a certificate of amalgamation in the prescribed form.
(2) If an amalgamation proposal specifies a date on which the
amalgamation is intended to become effective, and that date is the same as, or
later than, the date on which the Registrar receives the documents, the certificate
of amalgamation must be expressed to have effect on the date specified in the
amalgamation proposal.

146 Effect of certificate of amalgamation

On the date shown in a certificate of amalgamation –
(a) The amalgamation is effective; and
(b) Subject to section 10, the amalgamated company has the name
specified in the amalgamation proposal; and
(c) The amalgamated company is entitled to all the property, rights,
powers, and privileges of each of the amalgamating companies;
and
(d) The amalgamated company is subject to all the liabilities and
obligations of each of the amalgamating companies; and
(e) Proceedings pending by, or against, an amalgamating company may
be continued by, or against, the amalgamated company; and
(f) A conviction, ruling, order, or judgment in favour of, or against, an
amalgamating company may be enforced by, or against, the
amalgamated company; and
(g) Any provisions of the amalgamation proposal that provide for the
conversion of shares or rights of shareholders in the amalgamating
companies have effect according to their tenor.

Companies Act 2006

389

147 Registers

(1) If an amalgamation becomes effective, neither the Registrar of the Land
Court nor any other person charged with the keeping of any books or registers is
obliged, solely by reason of the amalgamation becoming effective, to change the
name of an amalgamating company to that of an amalgamated company in those
books or registers or in any documents.
(2) The presentation to the Registrar of the Land Court or any other person
of any instrument (whether or not comprising an instrument of transfer) by the
amalgamated company –
(a) Executed or appearing to be executed by the amalgamated
company; and
(b) Relating to any property held immediately before the amalgamation
by an amalgamating company; and
(c) Stating that that property has become the property of the
amalgamated company by virtue of this subpart –
is, in the absence of evidence to the contrary, sufficient evidence that the property
has become the property of the amalgamated company.
(3) Without limiting subsections (1) or (2), if any security issued by any
person or any rights or interests in property of any person become, by virtue of
this subpart, the property of an amalgamated company, that person, on
presentation of a certificate signed on behalf of the amalgamated company, stating
that that security or any such rights or interests have, by virtue of this subpart,
become the property of the amalgamated company, must, despite any other
enactment or rule of law or the provisions of any instrument, register the
amalgamated company as the holder of that security or as the person entitled to
such rights or interests, as the case may be.
(4) Except as expressly provided in this section, nothing in this subpart
derogates from the provisions of the Land Act 1969.

148 Powers of Court in relation to amalgamations

(1) If the Court is satisfied that giving effect to an amalgamation proposal
would unfairly prejudice a shareholder or creditor of an amalgamating company
or a person to whom an amalgamating company is under an obligation, it may, on
the application, made at any time before the date on which the amalgamation
becomes effective, of that person, make any order it thinks fit in relation to the
proposal, and may, without limiting the generality of this section, make an order –
(a) Directing that effect must not be given to the proposal;
(b) Modifying the proposal in such manner as may be specified in the
order;
(c) Directing the company or its directors to reconsider the proposal
or any part of it.
(2) An order may be made under subsection (1) on any conditions that the
Court thinks fit.

Subpart 2 – Approval of amalgamations, etc, by Court

149 Interpretation

In this subpart, unless the context otherwise requires –
arrangement includes a reorganisation of the share capital of a company by the
consolidation of shares of different classes, or by the division of shares into shares
of different classes, or by both those methods
390 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
company –
(a) Means a company; and
(b) Includes an overseas company that is registered on the overseas
register.

150 Approval of amalgamations, etc

(1) Subject to section 150, but despite any other provision or the rules of a
company, the Court may, on the application of a company or any shareholder or
creditor of a company, order that an amalgamation, arrangement, or compromise
is binding on the company and on any other persons or classes of persons specified
by the Court.
(2) The order may be made on any conditions that the Court thinks fit.
(3) An order made under this section has effect on and from the date
specified in the order.

151 When Court may approve amalgamations, etc

(1) An amalgamation, arrangement, or compromise may be approved
under this subpart only if it is not practicable for the amalgamation, arrangement,
or compromise to be effected under subpart 1 or subpart 2 of Part 9, or under
both.
(2) To avoid doubt, it is not impracticable for an amalgamation, arrangement, or compromise to be effected under subpart 1 or under subpart 2 of Part 9 by reason only that the compromise has not been, or would not be likely to be, approved in accordance with the procedure set out in those subparts.

152 Initial Court orders

(1) Before making an order under section 150(1), the Court may, on the
application of the company or any shareholder or creditor or other person who
appears to the Court to be interested, or of its own motion, make any 1 or more of
the following orders –
(a) An order that notice of the application, together with such
information relating to it as the Court thinks fit, be given in the
form and manner and to any persons or classes of persons specified
by the Court;
(b) An order directing the holding of a meeting or meetings of
shareholders or any class of shareholders or creditors or any class
of creditors of a company to consider and, if thought fit, to approve,
in such manner as the Court may specify, the proposed arrangement
or amalgamation or compromise and, for that purpose, the Court
may determine the shareholders or creditors that constitute a class
of shareholders or creditors of a company;
(c) An order requiring that a report on the proposed arrangement or
amalgamation or compromise be prepared for the Court by a person
specified by the Court and, if the Court thinks fit, be supplied to
the shareholders or any class of shareholders or creditors or any
class of creditors of a company or to any other person who appears
to the Court to be interested;
(d) An order as to the payment of the costs incurred in the preparation
of the report;
(e) An order specifying the persons who are entitled to appear and be
heard on the application to approve the amalgamation,
arrangement, or compromise.

Companies Act 2006

391
(2) In making an order under subsection (1), the Court must have regard to the procedures for amalgamations under subpart 1 and for compromises under subpart 2 of Part 9.
(3) An order made under this section has effect on and from the date specified in the order.

153 Court may make additional orders

(1) Without limiting section 150, the Court may, for the purpose of giving
effect to any amalgamation, arrangement, or compromise approved under that
section, either by the order approving the amalgamation, arrangement, or
compromise, or by any later order, provide for, and prescribe terms and conditions
relating to –
(a) The transfer or vesting of real or personal property, assets, rights,
powers, interests, liabilities, contracts, and engagements;
(b) The issue of shares, securities, or policies of any kind;
(c) The continuation of legal proceedings;
(d) The liquidation of any company;
(e) The provisions to be made for persons who voted against the
amalgamation, arrangement, or compromise at any meeting called
in accordance with any order made under section 152(1)(b) or who
appeared before the Court in opposition to the application to
approve the amalgamation, arrangement, or compromise;
(f) Any other matters that are necessary or desirable to give effect to
the amalgamation, arrangement, or compromise.
(2) An order made under this section has effect on and from the date
specified in the order.

154 Copy of orders to be delivered to Registrar

(1) Within 10 working days of an order being made by the Court under
this subpart, the company must ensure that a copy of the order is delivered to the
Registrar for registration.
(2) If a company fails to comply with subsection (1), every director of the
company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50
penalty units.

155 Application of section 209

Section 209 applies, with the necessary modifications, to any compromise
approved under section 151.

156 Purpose

PART 9
INSOLVENT COMPANIES

Subpart 1–Administrations

PURPOSE
(1) The purpose of this subpart and Schedules 8 to 12 is to provide for the business, property, and affairs of an insolvent company to be administered in a way that –
(a) Maximises the chances of the company, or the whole or any part of its business, continuing in existence as a viable business; or
(b) Results in a better return for the company’s creditors and
shareholders than would result from an immediate liquidation of
the company.
392 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) The provisions relating to administrations are set out in – (a) This subpart; and
(b) Schedules 8 and 9, which apply to administrators; and
(c) Schedule 10, which sets out the effect of administration; and
(d) Schedule 11, which applies to creditors’ committees; and
(e) Schedule 12, which, with the necessary modifications, applies to
meetings of creditors.

Beginning of administration

157 When administration begins

The administration of a company begins when an administrator of the
company is appointed.

Restrictions on appointment of administrator

158 Restrictions on appointment of administrator

(1) The following persons must not be appointed as an administrator –
(a) A person who must not be appointed as an administrator under
clause 1 of Schedule 9, unless the Court orders otherwise;
(b) A person who has not consented in writing to his or her appointment
as an administrator.
(2) Every person who acts as an administrator in contravention of
subsection (1)(a) commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 50 penalty units.

How administrator may be appointed

159 Who may appoint administrator

(1) An administrator of a company may be appointed by –
(a) The board of directors of a company; or
(b) If the company is in liquidation, the liquidator; or
(c) If an interim liquidator has been appointed, the interim liquidator;
or
(d) A chargeholder holding a charge over the whole, or substantially
the whole, of the company’s property; or
(e) The Court.
(2) If the company is already in administration, an administrator may be
appointed only by –
(a) The Court; or
(b) The creditors, as a replacement administrator for an administrator
that the creditors have removed; or
(c) The appointer of the first administrator, if that administrator has
died, resigned, or become disqualified.

160 Directors may appoint administrator

(1) The board of directors of a company may appoint an administrator of
the company if the board of directors has resolved at a meeting called under section
71 that –
(a) In the opinion of the directors voting for the resolution, the company is unable, or is likely to become unable, to pay its debts in the normal course of business; and
(b) An administrator of the company should be appointed for the purposes of achieving 1 of the purposes set out in section 156.

Companies Act 2006

393
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply –
(a) To a company that is already in liquidation;
(b) If a receiver has been appointed in respect of the whole of the
property of the company, unless the person by whom the receiver
was appointed has consented to the appointment of an
administrator;
(c) If an administrator has been appointed on a previous occasion,
unless leave of the Court is first obtained.
(3) The appointment must be in writing.

161 Liquidator may appoint administrator

(1) A liquidator or interim liquidator of a company may appoint an
administrator of the company if the liquidator or interim liquidator is of the opinion
that –
(a) The company is unable, or is likely to become unable, to pay its debts in the normal course of business; and
(b) An administrator should be appointed for the purposes of achieving
1 of the purposes set out in section 156.
(2) A liquidator or interim liquidator of a company may appoint himself
or herself as an administrator, with the leave of the Court.
(3) The appointment must be in writing.
(4) The appointment of any administrator while the company is in
liquidation does not terminate the appointment of the liquidator or interim
liquidator unless the Court makes such an order under section 254 on the
application of the liquidator or interim liquidator, or of the administrator.

162 Secured creditor may appoint administrator

(1) A person who is entitled to enforce a charge over all of a company’s
property may appoint an administrator of the company if –
(a) The charge has become, and is still, enforceable; and
(b) The secured creditor is of the opinion that an administrator should
be appointed for the purposes of achieving 1 of the purposes under
section 156.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to a company that is already in liquidation.
(3) The appointment must be in writing.

163 Appointment of administrator not to be revoked

The appointment of a person as administrator of a company may be revoked
only –
(a) By order of the Court under section 164; or
(b) By a decision of creditors under section 180 or under clause 6 of
Schedule 9 to appoint someone else as administrator of the company.

164 Court may remove administrator

On the application of the Registrar or of a creditor of the company
concerned, the Court may –
(a) Remove from office the administrator of a company under
administration or under a compromise approved under this subpart;
and
(b) Subject to section 158(1), appoint someone else as administrator of
the company or under the compromise.
394 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Notices

165 Notices given by administrator

(1) An administrator of a company must –
(a) Lodge a notice of the appointment with the Registrar before the
end of the next working day after the appointment; and
(b) Give public notice of the appointment within 10 working days after
the appointment; and
(c) Before the end of the next working day after the administrator is
appointed, give a written notice of the appointment to –
(i) every person who holds a charge on all of the company’s
property; and
(ii) every person who holds 1 or more charges on property of the
company if the property of the company subject to the charges
constitutes all, or substantially all, of the company’s property;
and
(iii) every secured party who holds a registered charge.
(2) An administrator need not give a notice under subsection (1)(c) to the
person who appointed the administrator.

166 Notice given by secured creditor

Before the end of the next working day after appointing an administrator
of a company, the secured creditor must give to the company a written notice of
the appointment.

167 Requirements for notices given under sections 165 or 166

A notice given under sections 165 or 166 must be in the prescribed form
and must contain –
(a) The full name of the administrator; and
(b) The date of appointment of the administrator; and
(c) The administrator ’s business address, telephone and fax numbers,
and email address (if any).

168 Notice of administration

(1) A company under administration must set out, in every agreement
entered into or document issued by the company, and in every negotiable
instrument, after the company’s name where it first appears, the expression
“(administrator appointed)” or, if an administrator has been appointed under
section 161, the expression “(administrator appointed and in liquidation)”.
(2) Every person who fails to comply with subsection (1) commits an
offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 25 penalty units.

Investigation of company’s affairs

169 Administrator to investigate company’s affairs

As soon as practicable after the administration of a company begins, the
administrator must –
(a) Investigate the company’s business, property, affairs, and financial
circumstances; and
(b) Form an opinion about each of the following matters –
(i) whether it would be in the interests of the company’s creditors
to approve a compromise binding on the company and its
creditors or a class of creditors;

Companies Act 2006

395
(ii) whether it would be in the creditors’ interests for the administration to end;
(iii) whether it would be in the creditors’ interests for a liquidator of the company to be appointed.

170 Directors to deliver documents to administrator

As soon as practicable after the administration of a company begins, each
director of the company must –
(a) Deliver to the administrator all records and documents in the
director ’s possession that relate to the company and that the director
is not entitled, as against the company and the administrator, to
retain; and
(b) If the director knows where other records and documents relating
to the company are, tell the administrator where they are.

171 Directors to give administrator statement of company’s affairs

(1) Within 5 working days after the administration of a company begins,
the directors must give to the administrator a statement about the company’s
business, property, affairs, and financial circumstances.
(2) The administrator may extend the time for compliance with subsection
(1).
(3) The administrator must table the directors’ statement – (a) At the first creditors’ meeting; or
(b) If the administrator has extended the time for compliance by the directors, at the watershed meeting.

172 Directors must give administrator other information

A director of a company under administration must –
(a) Attend on the administrator at any times that the administrator
reasonably requires; and
(b) Give the administrator all information about the company’s
business, property, affairs, and financial circumstances that the
administrator reasonably requires.

173 Offence not to comply with sections 170 to 172

A person who, without reasonable excuse, fails to comply with any of
sections 170 to 172 commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 50 penalty units.

Administrator’s rights to company’s documents

174 Restriction on enforcement of lien over company’s documents

(1) A person is not entitled, as against the administrator of a company, to –
(a) Retain possession of records and documents of the company; or
(b) Claim or enforce a lien on them.
(2) A lien is not, apart from subsection (1), otherwise prejudiced.

175 Delivery of company’s documents held by secured creditor

(1) Section 174 does not apply to a secured creditor who, otherwise than
because of a lien, is entitled to possession of records and documents of a company.
(2) Despite subsection (1), an administrator is, at any reasonable time,
entitled to inspect, and make copies of, those records and documents.
396 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

176 Notice to deliver company’s documents to administrator

(1) An administrator may give to a person a written notice requiring the
person to deliver to the administrator the records and documents of a company
that are specified in the notice and that are in the person’s possession.
(2) A notice under subsection (1) must specify a period of at least 3 working
days as the period within which the notice must be complied with.

177 Offence not to comply with sections 174 to 176

Every person who fails to comply with any of sections 174 to 176 commits
an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

First creditors’ meeting

178 Preparation for first creditors’ meeting

An administrator of a company must –
(a) Compile and maintain, for each class of creditors of the company, a
list of creditors known to the administrator, setting out –
(i) the amount owing or estimated to be owing to each of them;
and
(ii) the number of votes that each of them is entitled to cast at a
meeting of creditors held under this subpart; and
(b) Within 10 working days after the administration begins, hold a first
creditors’ meeting.

179 Notice of first creditors’ meeting

At least 5 working days before the first creditors’ meeting, the administrator
must give –
(a) Written notice of the meeting to all secured parties who hold a
registered charge over any property of the company; and
(b) Written notice of the meeting to as many of the company’s other
creditors as reasonably practicable; and
(c) Public notice of the meeting.

180 Proceedings at first creditors’ meeting’

(1) At the first creditors’ meeting, the company’s creditors may, by
resolution –
(a) Determine whether to appoint a creditors’ committee, and, if so,
appoint the committee’s members; or
(b) Appoint someone else as administrator of the company; or
(c) End the administration.
(2) Schedule 11 applies to creditors’ committees.
(3) Schedule 12 applies, with the necessary modifications, to meetings of
creditors held under this subpart (including meetings of creditors’ committees).

181 Offence not to comply with sections 178 or 179

Every person who does not comply with sections 178 or 179 commits an
offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

Companies Act 2006

397

Reports by administrators

182 Reports by administrators

(1) In the circumstances set out in subsection (2), an administrator of a
company must –
(a) Lodge a report with the Registrar about the matter as soon as
practicable; and
(b) Give the Registrar any information, and access to any facilities for
inspecting and taking copies of documents, that the Registrar
requires.
(2) The circumstances are that it appears to the administrator that –
(a) A past or present officer, or a shareholder, of the company may
have been guilty of an offence in relation to the company; or
(b) A person who has taken part in the formation, promotion,
administration, management, or liquidation of the company may
have –
(i) misapplied or retained, or may have become liable or
accountable for, money or property (in Niue or elsewhere) of
the company; or
(ii) been guilty of negligence, default, breach of duty, or breach of
trust in relation to the company.
(3) The administrator may also lodge further reports specifying any other
matter that, in his or her opinion, should be brought to the Registrar ’s notice.

183 Court may direct administrator to lodge report

(1) In the circumstances set out in subsection (2), the Court may, on the
application of an interested person or of its own motion, direct the administrator
to lodge a report.
(2) The circumstances are that –
(a) It appears to the Court that –
(i) a past or present officer, or a shareholder, of a company under
administration has been guilty of an offence in relation to the
company; or
(ii) a person who has taken part in the formation, promotion,
administration, management, or liquidation of a company
under administration has engaged in conduct of a kind referred
to in section 181(2)(b)(i) or (ii) in relation to the company; and
(b) The administrator has not lodged a report about the matter.

Watershed meeting

184 What is watershed meeting

The watershed meeting is the meeting of creditors called by the
administrator to decide the future of the company and, in particular, whether the
company and creditors should enter into a compromise under subpart 2.

185 Administrator must convene watershed meeting

(1) The administrator must convene the watershed meeting within the
convening period.
(2) The convening period is the period of 20 working days after the date
on which the administrator is appointed, and includes any period for which it is
extended under subsection (3).
398 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) The Court may, on the administrator ’s application, extend the convening period, but must not do so if the application is made after the convening period has expired, unless the Court is satisfied that a substantial injustice will result if the convening period is not extended.

186 Notice of watershed meeting

(1) The administrator must convene the watershed meeting by –
(a) Giving written notice of the meeting to as many of the company’s
creditors as reasonably practicable; and
(b) Publishing a notice of the meeting in a national newspaper.
(2) The administrator must take the steps in subsection (1) not less than 5
working days before the meeting.
(3) The notice given to creditors under subsection (1)(a) must be
accompanied by –
(a) A report by the administrator about the company’s business,
property, affairs, and financial circumstances and setting out the
basis of remuneration or proposed remuneration of the
administrator; and
(b) A statement setting out the administrator ’s opinion (including his
or her reasons for the opinion) about each of the following matters –
(i) whether it would be in the creditors’ interests for the company
to enter into a compromise that is binding on the company and
its creditors or a class of creditors;
(ii) whether it would be in the creditors’ interests for the
administration to end;
(iii) whether it would be in the creditors’ interests for a liquidator
of the company to be appointed; and
(c) If a compromise is proposed, a statement setting out details of the
proposed compromise in accordance with section 205(2)(b), but it
is not necessary for the administrator to give a separate notice under
that section; and
(d) A copy of the list or lists of creditors referred to in section 178.

187 When watershed meeting must be held

(1) The watershed meeting must be held within 5 working days after the
end of the convening period or extended convening period, as the case may be.
(2) The watershed meeting may be adjourned, but only to a day that is not
more than 30 working days after the first day on which the meeting was held.
(3) However, the Court may, on the administrator ’s application, order that
the meeting be adjourned for more than 30 working days.

188 What creditors may decide at watershed meeting

(1) At a watershed meeting, the creditors may resolve –
(a) To approve a compromise that is binding on its creditors or a class
of creditors as specified in the resolution (even if it differs from the
proposed compromise (if any), details of which accompanied the
notice of meeting, as a result of any amendment adopted at the
meeting); or
(b) That the administration should end; or
(c) If the administrator has so recommended, that a liquidator of the
company be appointed.
(2) Despite anything in Schedule 12 –

Companies Act 2006

399
(a) A resolution for the purposes of subsection (1)(a) is adopted if a majority in number and value of the creditors or class of creditors, voting in person or by proxy, vote in favour of the resolution; and
(b) Section 206(3) applies to such a resolution.

End of administration

189 When administration ends

The administration of a company ends on the happening of whichever event
of a kind referred to in sections 190 or 191 happens first after the administration
begins.

190 Normal way for administration to end

The normal outcome of the administration of a company is that –
(a) A compromise is approved by creditors that is binding on the
company and its creditors or a class of creditors; or
(b) The company’s creditors resolve that the administration should end;
or
(c) The company’s creditors resolve that a liquidator of the company
be appointed.

191 Other ways in which administration may end

The administration of a company may also end because –
(a) the Court orders that the administration is to end, for example,
because the Court is satisfied that the company is solvent; or
(b) The convening period for a watershed meeting ends –
(i) without the meeting being convened in accordance with section
186; and
(ii) without an application being made for the Court to extend the
convening period for the watershed meeting; or
(c) An application for the Court to extend the convening period is
finally determined or otherwise disposed of other than by the Court
extending the convening period; or
(d) The convening period, as extended, ends without the meeting being
convened in accordance with section 186; or
(e) A watershed meeting called under section 184 ends (whether or
not it was earlier adjourned) without a resolution under section
188(1) being passed at the meeting; or
(f) The Court appoints an interim liquidator of the company or
appoints a liquidator of the company.

192 Notice of end of administration

If a meeting of the company’s creditors resolves that the administration
should end, or resolves that a liquidator be appointed, the administrator must,
immediately after the declaration of the result of the resolution of creditors –
(a) Lodge a notice with the Registrar that the administration is at an
end or that a liquidator has been appointed, as the case may be;
and
(b) Cause a public notice to be published that the administration is at
an end or that a liquidator has been appointed, as the case may be.
400 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Creditors’ resolution approving compromise

193 Effect of creditors’ resolution approving compromise

If, at a creditors’ meeting, a company’s creditors approve a compromise –
(a) The administrator of the company is the administrator under the
compromise unless the creditors, by resolution passed at the
meeting, appoint someone else to be administrator under the
compromise; and
(b) The administrator must prepare a document setting out the terms
of the compromise (compromise document).

194 Contents of compromise document

The compromise document must specify all the following –
(a) The administrator of the compromise and the basis for determining
his or her remuneration;
(b) The property of the company (whether or not already owned by
the company when it executes the deed) that is to be available to
pay creditors’ claims;
(c) The nature and duration of any moratorium period for which the
compromise provides;
(d) To what extent (if any) the company is to be released from its debts;
(e) The conditions (if any) for the compromise to come into operation;
(f) The conditions (if any) for the compromise to continue in operation;
(g) The circumstances in which the compromise terminates;
(h) The order in which proceeds of realising the property referred to in
paragraph (b) will be distributed among creditors bound by the
compromise;
(i) The day (not later than the day when the administration began) on
or before which creditors’ claims must have arisen if they are to be
admissible under the compromise;
(j) Any other matters prescribed by regulations.

195 Application of subpart 2 to compromise proposed by administrator

The provisions of subpart 2 apply to a compromise proposed by an
administrator except as expressly modified or excluded by this subpart.

196 Notice of approval of compromise

(1) Within 10 working days after a compromise is approved at a creditors’
meeting, the administrator must –
(a) Send a written notice of the result of the voting of the creditors to –
(i) each creditor of the company; and
(ii) the company; and
(iii) any receiver of the company; and
(iv) any liquidator of the company; and
(b) Give public notice of the result of the voting of the creditors; and
(c) Give written notice of the voting of the creditors to, and lodge a
copy of the compromise document with, the Registrar.
(2) Every person who fails to comply with subsection (1) commits an
offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

Companies Act 2006

401

Creditors’ resolution approving appointment of liquidator

197 Creditors’ resolution approving appointment of liquidator

(1) If a company’s creditors approve the appointment of a liquidator –
(a) Subject to subsection (3), the administrator is the liquidator with
effect from the date and time at which the resolution is passed; and
(b) The liquidator need not –
(i) call a meeting of creditors; or
(ii) give a notice under section 237(1); or
(iii) give public notice if the liquidator has lodged a notice with the
Registrar under section 237(2); but
(c) Except as expressly provided otherwise, subpart 3 applies, with
the necessary modifications, to the liquidation.
(2) The administrator must record the time and date at which the resolution
was passed or the contravention occurred, and the time and date at which the
administration begins.
(3) The creditors may, by resolution, appoint a named person other than
the administrator to be the liquidator of the company. If that person has consented
in writing to the appointment before it is made, that person is the liquidator with
effect from the date and time at which the resolution is passed. Otherwise, that
person becomes liquidator with effect from the date and time at which he or she
consents in writing to the appointment, and until such time the administrator is
the liquidator in accordance with subsection (1).

198 Notice of appointment of liquidator

Within 10 working days after the day on which the liquidator is appointed
at a creditors’ meeting, the liquidator must lodge with the Registrar a written
notice –
(a) Stating that a liquidator of the company has been appointed; and
(b) Specifying the date on which, and time at which, the liquidation
begins.

Protection of persons during administration

199 Protection of persons dealing with administrator, etc

(1) A person is entitled, in relation to the person’s dealings with an
administrator of a company or another person who has, or appears to have, directly
or indirectly acquired title to property of the company from the administrator, to
assume that –
(a) The company’s rules and this Act have been complied with;
(b) Any person who appears, from information provided by the
administrator or company that is available to the public, to be an
administrator of the company –
(i) has been appointed; and
(ii) has authority to exercise the powers and perform the functions
customarily exercised or performed by an administrator of a
similar company;
(c) Anyone who is held out by an administrator or the company to be
an agent of the administrator or an officer or agent of the company –
(i) has been appointed; and
(ii) has authority to exercise the powers and perform the functions
customarily exercised or performed by that kind of officer or
agent of a similar company or by that kind of agent of the
administrator;
402 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) The administrator, officers and agents of the company, and agents of the administrator, properly perform their duties to the company;
(e) A document has been duly executed by the company if the document appears to have been signed by the administrator;
(f) A document has been executed by a company that has a common seal if –
(i) the company’s common seal appears to have been fixed to the document; and
(ii) the fixing of the common seal appears to have been witnessed
by the administrator;
(g) An administrator of the company who has authority to issue a
document or a certified copy of a document on its behalf also has
authority to warrant that the document is genuine or is a copy.
(2) Subsection (1) –
(a) Applies even if the administrator or an officer or agent of the
company acts fraudulently, or forges a document, in connection
with the dealings; but
(b) Does not apply if the person who is entitled to make the assumptions
in that subsection knew or suspected that the assumption was
incorrect.

200 Validity of things done during administration

A payment made, transaction entered into, or any other act or thing done,
in good faith, by, or with the consent of, the administrator of a company under
administration –
(a) Is valid and effectual for the purposes of this Act; and
(b) Is not liable to be set aside in a liquidation of the company.

201 General power to make orders

(1) The Court may, on any conditions that it thinks fit, make any order that
it thinks appropriate about how this subpart is to operate in relation to the
administration of a particular company (for example, that the administration of
the company is to end).
(2) An order may be made on the application of –
(a) The company; or
(b) A creditor of the company; or
(c) In the case of a company under administration, the administrator
of the company; or
(d) In the case of a company that has entered into a compromise, the
administrator (if any) under the compromise; or
(e) The Registrar; or
(f) Any other interested person.

202 Court orders protecting creditors or shareholders

The Court may, on the application of the Registrar or of a creditor or
shareholder of a company, make any order that the Court thinks just if the Court
is satisfied that the administrator of a company under administration, or under a
compromise –
(a) Has managed, or is managing, the company’s business, property,
or affairs in a way that is prejudicial to the interests of some or all of
the company’s creditors or shareholders; or
(b) Has acted or has not acted, or proposes to act or not to act, in a way
that is or would be prejudicial to those interests.

Companies Act 2006

403

203 Court orders to protect creditors during administration

(1) The Court may, on the application of the Registrar or of a creditor of a
company, make any order that it thinks necessary to protect the interests of the
company’s creditors while the company is under administration.
(2) An order may be made subject to conditions.

Subpart 2 – Compromises with creditors

204 Compromise proposal

Any of the following persons may propose a compromise under this subpart
if that person has reason to believe that a company is or will be unable to pay its
debts as they become due in the normal course of business –
(a) The directors of the company;
(b) A receiver appointed in relation to the whole or substantially the
whole of the assets and undertaking of the company;
(c) A liquidator or an administrator of the company.

205 Notice of proposed compromise

(1) The proponent must compile, in relation to each class of creditors of
the company, a list of creditors known to the proponent who would be affected by
the proposed compromise, setting out –
(a) The amount owing or estimated to be owing to each of them; and
(b) The number of votes that each of them is entitled to cast on a
resolution to approve the compromise.
(2) The proponent must give to each known creditor, the company, any
receiver or liquidator, and deliver to the Registrar for registration –
(a) Notice in accordance with Schedule 12 of the intention to hold a
meeting of creditors, or any 2 or more classes of creditors, for the
purpose of voting on the resolution; and
(b) A statement –
(i) containing the name and address of the proponent and the
capacity in which the proponent is acting; and
(ii) containing the address and telephone number to which
inquiries may be directed during normal business hours; and
(iii) setting out the terms of the proposed compromise and the
reasons for it; and
(iv) setting out the reasonably foreseeable consequences for
creditors of the company of the compromise being approved;
and
(v) setting out the extent of any interest of a director in the proposed
compromise; and
(vi) Explaining that the proposed compromise and any amendment
to it proposed at a meeting of creditors or any classes of creditors
will be binding on all creditors, or on all creditors of that class,
if approved in accordance with section 206; and
(vii) containing details of any procedure proposed as part of the
proposed compromise for varying the compromise following
its approval; and
(c) A copy of the list or lists of creditors referred to in subsection (1).
404 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

206 Effect of compromise

(1) A compromise, including any amendment proposed at the meeting, is
approved by creditors, or a class of creditors, if, at a meeting of creditors or that
class of creditors conducted in accordance with Schedule 12, the compromise,
including any amendment, is adopted in accordance with that schedule.
(2) A compromise, including any amendment, approved by creditors or a
class of creditors of a company in accordance with this subpart is binding on the
company and on all creditors, or, if there is more than 1 class of creditors, on all
creditors of that class, to whom notice of the proposal was given.
(3) If a resolution proposing a compromise, including any amendment, is
put to the vote of more than 1 class of creditors, it is to be presumed, unless the
contrary is expressly stated in the resolution, that the approval of the compromise,
including any amendment, by each class is conditional on the approval of the
compromise, including any amendment, by every other class voting on the
resolution.
(4) The proponent must give written notice of the result of the voting to
each known creditor, the company, any receiver or liquidator, and the Registrar.

207 Variation of compromise

(1) An approved compromise may be varied or terminated either –
(a) In accordance with any procedure for variation or termination
incorporated in the compromise as approved; or
(b) by the approval of a proposal to vary or terminate the compromise
in accordance with this subpart that, for that purpose, applies, with
all necessary modifications, as if any the proposal were a proposed
compromise.
(2) This subpart applies to any compromise that is varied in accordance
with this section.

208 Powers of Court

(1) On the application of the proponent or the company, the Court may –
(a) Give directions in relation to a procedural requirement imposed by
this subpart, or waive or vary any such requirement, if it is satisfied
that it would be just to do so; or
(b) Order that, during a period specified in the order, beginning not
earlier than the date on which notice was given of the proposed
compromise and ending not later than 10 working days after the
date on which notice was given of the result of the voting on it –
(i) Proceedings in relation to a debt owing by the company be
stayed; or
(ii) A creditor refrain from taking any other measure to enforce
payment of a debt owing by the company.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1)(b) affects the right of a secured creditor during
that period to take possession of, realise, or otherwise deal with, property of the
company over which that creditor has a charge.
(3) The Court may order that the creditor is not bound by the compromise
or make any other order that it thinks fit if the Court is satisfied, on the application
of a creditor of a company who was entitled to vote on a compromise, that –
(a) Not enough notice of the meeting or of the matter required to be
notified under section 205 was given to that creditor; or
(b) There was some other material irregularity in obtaining approval
of the compromise; or

Companies Act 2006

405
(c) In the case of a creditor who voted against the compromise, the compromise is unfairly prejudicial to that creditor, or to the class of creditors to which that creditor belongs.
(4) An application under subsection (3) must be made not later than 10 working days after the date on which notice of the result of the voting was given to the creditor.

209 Effect of compromise in liquidation of company

(1) If a compromise is approved, the Court may, on the application of –
(a) The company; or
(b) A receiver appointed in relation to property of the company; or
(c) With the leave of the Court, any creditor or shareholder of the
company –
make such order as the Court thinks fit with respect to the extent, if any, to which
the compromise will, if the company is put into liquidation, continue in effect and
be binding on the liquidator of the company.
(2) If a compromise is approved and the company is later put into
liquidation, the Court may, on the application of any person described in subsection
(3), make any order that the Court thinks fit with respect to the extent, if any, to
which the compromise will continue in effect and be binding on the liquidator of
the company.
(3) The persons referred to in subsection (2) are –
(a) The liquidator; or
(b) A receiver appointed in relation to property of the company; or
(c) With the leave of the Court, any creditor or shareholder of the
company.

210 Costs of compromise

Unless the Court orders otherwise, the costs incurred in organising and
conducting a meeting of creditors for the purpose of voting on a proposed
compromise –
(a) Must be met by the company; or
(b) If incurred by a receiver or an administrator or a liquidator, are a
cost of the receivership or administration or liquidation; or
(c) If incurred by any other person, are a debt due to that person by
the company.

211 Purpose

Subpart 3–Liquidations

PURPOSE
(1) The purpose of this subpart and Schedules 12 to 18 is to provide for a liquidator of a company –
(a) To take possession of, protect, realise, and distribute the assets, or the proceeds of the realisation of the assets, of the company to its creditors in accordance with this Act; and
(b) If there are surplus assets remaining, to distribute them, or the proceeds of the realisation of the surplus assets, in accordance with section 250.
(2) The provisions relating to liquidations are set out in – (a) This subpart; and
(b) Schedule 12, which, with the necessary modifications, applies to meetings of creditors; and
406 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) Schedules 13 and 14, which apply to liquidators; and
(d) Schedule 15, which sets out the effect of liquidation; and
(e) Schedule 16, which applies to liquidation committees; and
(f) Schedule 17, which applies to voidable transactions and charges
and recoveries in other cases in a liquidation; and
(g) Schedule 18, which applies to creditors’ claims.

Beginning of liquidation

212 When liquidation begins

(1) The liquidation of a company begins on the date on which, and at the
time at which, the liquidator is appointed.
(2) The liquidator must be a named person.
(3) If any question arises as to whether, on the date on which a liquidator
was appointed, an act was done or a transaction was entered into or effected before
or after the time at which the liquidator was appointed, that act or transaction is,
in the absence of proof to the contrary, deemed to have been done or entered into
or effected, as the case may be, after that time.

Restrictions on appointment of liquidator

213 Restrictions on appointment of liquidator

(1) Unless the Court orders otherwise, none of the persons referred to in
clause 1 of Schedule 14 may be appointed or act as a liquidator of a company.
(2) The appointment of a person as a liquidator is of no effect unless that
person has consented in writing to the appointment.
(3) Every person who acts as a liquidator in contravention of subsection
(1) commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.

How liquidator may be appointed

214 Board may appoint liquidator

(1) A liquidator may be appointed by the resolution of the board of directors
of the company on the occurrence of an event specified in the company’s rules.
(2) The board of directors of the company must record, in the document
appointing the liquidator, the date on which, and the time at which, the liquidator
was appointed.

215 Shareholders may appoint liquidator

(1) A liquidator may be appointed by special resolution of those
shareholders entitled to vote and voting on the question.
(2) The shareholders must record in the special resolution appointing the
liquidator the date on which, and the time at which, the special resolution was
passed.

216 Creditors may appoint liquidator

A liquidator may be appointed by resolution of the creditors of the company
under administration in accordance with section 188(1)(c).

217 Court may appoint liquidator

(1) A liquidator may be appointed by the Court on the application of –
(a) The company; or
(b) A director of the company; or
(c) A shareholder of the company; or

Companies Act 2006

407
(d) A creditor of the company (including any contingent or prospective creditor); or
(e) An administrator under a compromise approved at a creditors’
meeting; or
(f) The Registrar.
(2) The Court may appoint a liquidator if it is satisfied that –
(a) The company is unable to pay its debts; or
(b) The company or the directors have persistently or seriously failed
to comply with this Act; or
(d) It is just and equitable that the company be put into liquidation.
(3) The Court must record in the order appointing the liquidator the date
on which, and the time at which, the order was made.

218 Interim liquidator

(1) If an application has been made to the Court for an order that a company
be put into liquidation, the Court may, if it is satisfied that it is necessary or
expedient for the purpose of maintaining the value of assets owned or managed
by the company, appoint a named person as interim liquidator.
(2) Subject to subsection (3), an interim liquidator has the rights and powers
of a liquidator to the extent necessary or desirable to maintain the value of assets
owned or managed by the company, including power to appoint an administrator.
(3) The Court may limit the rights and powers of an interim liquidator in
the manner that it thinks fit.
(4) The appointment of an interim liquidator takes effect on the date on
which, and at the time at which, the order appointing that interim liquidator is
made.
(5) The Court must record in the order appointing the interim liquidator the date on which, and the time at which, the order was made.
(6) If any question arises as to whether, on the date on which an interim
liquidator was appointed, an act was done or a transaction was entered into or
effected before or after the time at which the interim liquidator was appointed,
that act or transaction is, in the absence of proof to the contrary, deemed to have
been done or entered into or effected, as the case may be, after that time.

219 Meaning of unable to pay its debts

Unless the contrary is proved, and subject to section 220, a company is
presumed to be unable to pay its debts if –
(a) The company has failed to comply with a statutory demand; or
(b) Execution issued against the company in respect of a judgment debt
has been returned unsatisfied in whole or in part; or
(c) A person entitled to a charge over all or substantially all of the
property of the company has appointed a receiver under the
document creating the charge; or
(d) A compromise between a company and its creditors has been put
to a vote in accordance with subpart 2.

220 Evidence and other matters

(1) On an application to the Court for an order that a company be put into
liquidation, evidence of failure to comply with a statutory demand is not admissible
as evidence that a company is unable to pay its debts unless the application is
made within 30 working days after the last date for compliance with the demand.
408 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) Section 219 does not prevent proof by other means that a company is unable to pay its debts.
(3) Information or records acquired under section 57 or, if the Court so orders, under section 62, may be received as evidence that a company is unable to pay its debts.
(4) In determining whether a company is unable to pay its debts, contingent
or prospective liabilities may be taken into account.
(5) An application to the Court for an order that a company be put into
liquidation on the ground that it is unable to pay its debts may be made by a
contingent or prospective creditor only with the leave of the Court; and the Court
may give such leave, with or without conditions, only if it is satisfied that a prima
facie case has been made out that the company is unable to pay its debts.

221 Statutory demand

(1) A statutory demand is a demand by a creditor in respect of a debt owing
by a company made in accordance with this section.
(2) A statutory demand must –
(a) be in respect of a debt that is due and is not less than the prescribed
amount; and
(b) Be in writing; and
(c) Be served on the company; and
(d) Require the company to do any of the following things to the
reasonable satisfaction of the creditor, within 15 working days of
the date of service, or any longer period that the Court may order –
(i) pay the debt;
(ii) enter into a compromise under subpart 2;
(iii) otherwise compound with the creditor;
(iv) give a charge over its property to secure payment of the debt.

222 Court may set aside statutory demand

(1) The Court may, on the application of the company, set aside a statutory
demand.
(2) The application must be –
(a) Made within 10 working days of the date of service of the demand;
and
(b) Served on the creditor within 10 working days of the date of service
of the demand.
(3) No extension of time may be given for making or serving an application
to have a statutory demand set aside, but, at the hearing of the application, the
Court may extend the time for compliance with the statutory demand.
(4) The Court may grant an application to set aside a statutory demand if
it is satisfied that –
(a) There is a substantial dispute as to whether or not the debt is owing
or is due; or
(b) The company appears to have a counterclaim, set-off, or cross-
demand and the amount specified in the demand less the amount
of the counterclaim, set-off, or cross-demand is less than the
prescribed amount; or
(c) The demand ought to be set aside on other grounds.
(5) A demand must not be set aside by reason only of a defect or irregularity
unless the Court considers that substantial injustice would be caused if it were
not set aside.

Companies Act 2006

409
(6) In subsection (5), defect includes a material misstatement of the amount due to the creditor and a material misdescription of the debt referred to in the demand.
(7) An order under this section may be made subject to conditions.

223 Additional powers of Court on application to set aside statutory demand (1) If, on the hearing of an application under section 222, the Court is satisfied that there is a debt due by the company to the creditor that is not the subject of a substantial dispute, or is not subject to a counterclaim, set-off, or cross- demand, the Court may, on the ground that the company is unable to pay its

debts –
(a) Order the company to pay the debt within a specified period and that, in default of payment, the creditor may make an application to put the company into liquidation; or
(b) Dismiss the application and immediately make an order putting
the company into liquidation.
(2) For the purposes of the hearing of an application to put the company
into liquidation under an order made under subsection (1)(a), the company is
presumed to be unable to pay its debts if it failed to pay the debt within the specified
period under the order.

224 Notices given by liquidator

NOTICES
(1) A liquidator must, immediately after being appointed or being notified of his or her appointment, give public notice of –
(a) The liquidator ’s appointment; and
(b) The date and time of the commencement of the liquidation; and
(c) The address, telephone and fax numbers, and email address to
which, during normal business hours, inquiries may be directed
by a creditor or shareholder.
(2) A liquidator must, within 10 working days of being appointed or being
notified of his or her appointment, deliver to the Registrar for registration a notice
of the liquidator ’s appointment.

225 Documents to state company in liquidation

Every document entered into, made, or issued by a liquidator of a company
on behalf of the company must state, in a prominent position, that the company is
in liquidation.

Obligations to liquidators

226 Directors, etc, to identify and deliver company property

(1) A present or former director or employee of a company in liquidation
must –
(a) Immediately after the company is put into liquidation, give the liquidator details of property of the company in his or her possession or under his or her control; and
(b) On being required to do so by the liquidator, immediately or within any time that may be specified by the liquidator, deliver the property to the liquidator or any other person that the liquidator may direct, or dispose of the property in any manner that the liquidator may direct.
410 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) A person who fails to comply with subsection (1) commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years or to a fine not exceeding 250 penalty units, or both.

227 Obligations of suppliers of essential services

(1) Despite any other Act or any contract, a supplier of an essential service
must not –
(a) Refuse to supply the service to a liquidator, or to a company in liquidation, by reason of the company’s default in paying charges due for the service in relation to a period before the commencement of the liquidation; or
(b) Make it a condition of the supply of the service to a liquidator, or to
a company in liquidation, that payment be made of outstanding
charges due for the service in relation to a period before the
commencement of the liquidation; or
(c) Make it a condition of the supply of the service to a company in
liquidation that the liquidator personally guarantees payment of
the charges that would be incurred for the supply of the service.
(2) The charges incurred by a liquidator for the supply of an essential
service are an expense incurred by the liquidator for the purposes of clause 15(a)
of Schedule 18.

Liquidators’ rights to company’s documents

228 Liquidator may require director, etc, to deliver documents

A liquidator may, by notice in writing, require a director or shareholder of
the company or any other person to deliver to the liquidator any records or
documents of the company in that person’s possession or under that person’s
control as the liquidator requires.

229 Liquidator may require director, etc, to provide information

(1) A liquidator may, from time to time, by notice in writing, require the
following persons to do any of the things specified in subsection (2) –
(a) A director or former director of the company;
(b) A shareholder of the company;
(c) A person who was involved in the promotion or formation of the
company;
(d) A person who is, or has been, an employee of the company;
(e) A receiver, administrator, accountant, auditor, bank officer, or other
person having knowledge of the affairs of the company;
(f) A person who is acting, or who has at any time acted, as a solicitor
for the company.
(2) A person referred to in subsection (1) may be required to –
(a) Attend on the liquidator at such reasonable time or times and at
such place as may be specified in the notice;
(b) Provide the liquidator with such information about the business,
accounts, or affairs of the company as the liquidator requests;
(c) be examined on oath or affirmation by the liquidator or by a barrister
or solicitor acting on behalf of the liquidator on any matter relating
to the business, accounts, or affairs of the company;
(d) Assist in the liquidation to the best of the person’s ability.
(3) Without limiting subsection (2)(a), a person may be required to attend
on the liquidator under that subsection at a meeting of creditors of the company.

Companies Act 2006

411

230 Reasonable expenses may be paid

(1) Without limiting subsection (2), the liquidator may pay to a person
referred to in section 229(1)(d), (e), or (f), who is not an employee of the company,
reasonable travelling and other expenses in complying with a requirement of the
liquidator under that section.
(2) The Court may, on the application of the liquidator or a person referred
to in section 229(1)(d), (e), or (f), who is not an employee of the company, order
that that person is entitled to receive reasonable remuneration and travelling and
other expenses in complying with a requirement of the liquidator under that
section.
(3) A person referred to in section 229(1)(d), (e), or (f) is not entitled to
refuse to comply with a requirement of the liquidator under that section by reason
only that –
(a) An application to the Court to be paid remuneration or travelling and other expenses has not been made or determined; or
(b) Remuneration or travelling and other expenses to which that person is entitled have not been paid in advance; or
(c) The liquidator has not paid that person travelling or other expenses.

231 Examination by liquidator

(1) A liquidator, or a barrister or solicitor acting on behalf of the liquidator,
may administer an oath to, or take the affirmation of, a person required to be
examined under section 229.
(2) A person required to be examined under section 229 is entitled to be
represented by a barrister or solicitor.
(3) A liquidator, or a barrister or solicitor acting on behalf of the liquidator,
who conducts an examination under section 229 must ensure that the examination
is recorded in writing or by means of a sound recording, video and sound recording,
or other similar means.

232 Court may order person to comply with section 228

(1) The Court may, on the application of the liquidator, order a person
who has failed to comply with a requirement of the liquidator under section 229
to comply with that requirement.
(2) The Court may, on the application of the liquidator, order a person to
whom section 229 applies to –
(a) Attend before the Court and be examined on oath or affirmation
by the Court or the liquidator, or a barrister or solicitor acting on
behalf of the liquidator, on any matter relating to the business,
accounts, or affairs of the company;
(b) Produce any documents relating to the business, accounts, or affairs
of the company in that person’s possession or under that person’s
control.
(3) If a person is examined under subsection (2)(a) –
(a) The examination must be recorded in writing; and
(b) The person examined must sign the record.
(4) Subject to any directions by the Court, a record of an examination under
this section is admissible in evidence in any proceedings under section 78 or this
subpart.
412 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

233 Self-incrimination no excuse

(1) A person is not excused from answering a question in the course of
being examined under sections 229 or 232 on the ground that the answer may
incriminate or tend to incriminate that person.
(2) The testimony of the person examined is not admissible as evidence in
criminal proceedings against that person except on a charge of perjury in relation
to that testimony.

234 Restriction on enforcement of lien over company’s documents

(1) A person is not entitled, as against the liquidator of a company, to claim
or enforce a lien over documents of the company.
(2) If the lien arises in relation to a debt for the provision of services to the
company before the commencement of the liquidation, the debt is a preferential
claim against the company under section 249 to the extent of $500 or such greater
amount as may be prescribed at the commencement of the liquidation.
(3) Nothing in this section applies to a company that was put into
liquidation under sections 214 or 215 if –
(a) The directors of the company passed a resolution of the kind referred
to in section 241; and
(b) Section 242 does not apply in relation to the company.

235 Delivery of document held by secured creditor

(1) A person is required to deliver a document to a liquidator under section
228 even though possession of the document creates a charge over property of a
company.
(2) Production of the document to the liquidator does not prejudice the
existence or priority of the charge, and the liquidator must make the document
available to the person entitled to it for the purpose of dealing with, or realising
the charge over, the secured property.

236 Documents held by receiver

(1) A receiver is not required to deliver to a liquidator any documents that
the receiver requires for the purpose of exercising any powers or functions as
receiver in relation to property of a company in liquidation.
(2) The liquidator may, from time to time, by notice in writing, require the
receiver –
(a) To make any records and documents available for inspection by the liquidator at any reasonable time or times; and
(b) To provide the liquidator with copies of any records and documents or extracts from them.
(3) The liquidator may take copies of any records and documents made
available for inspection or extracts from them.
(4) The liquidator must pay the reasonable expenses of the receiver in
complying with a requirement of the liquidator under subsection (2).

Companies Act 2006

413

Meetings

237 Notice of first creditors’ meeting

(1) A liquidator must give to every known creditor a notice in writing of a
meeting of creditors, and –
(a) If section 246(1) applies, the notice must be given together with the
report and notice referred to in that subsection; and
(b) If the liquidator receives a notice under section 243(1)(c) requiring
a meeting of creditors to be called, the notice must be given within
10 working days after receiving the notice.
(2) Not less than 5 working days before the creditors’ meeting, a liquidator
must also give public notice of the meeting.

238 Timing of first creditors’ meeting

(1) Except if section 237(1)(b) applies, a meeting of creditors must be held –
(a) In the case of a liquidator appointed under sections 214 or 215,
within 10 working days of the liquidator ’s appointment; or
(b) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 217, within 30
working days of the liquidator ’s appointment; or
(c) In either case, within such longer period as the Court may allow.
(2) If section 237(1)(b) applies, a meeting of creditors must be held within
15 working days after the liquidator receives a notice under section 243(1)(c)
requiring a meeting of creditors to be called.

239 Purpose of first creditors’ meeting

(1) Subject to sections 241 and 243, the liquidator of a company must call a
meeting of the creditors of the company for the purpose –
(a) In the case of a liquidator appointed under sections 214 or 215, of
resolving whether to confirm the appointment of that liquidator or
to appoint another liquidator in place of the liquidator so appointed;
(b) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 217, of resolving
whether to confirm the appointment of that liquidator or to make
an application to the Court for the appointment of a liquidator in
place of the liquidator so appointed;
(c) In either case, of determining whether to pass a resolution for the
purposes of section 245(1)(c).
(2) If the appointment of a liquidator under sections 214 or 215 is not
confirmed at a meeting of creditors and another liquidator is not appointed in
place of that liquidator, the appointment of the liquidator under either of those
sections continues until another liquidator is appointed.

240 Replacement liquidator

(1) If at a meeting of creditors it is resolved to appoint a person as liquidator
of the company in place of the liquidator appointed under sections 214 or 215, the
person who it is resolved to appoint as liquidator is, subject to section 213,
appointed as the liquidator of the company.
(2) If at a meeting of creditors it is resolved to apply to the Court for the
appointment of a person as liquidator in place of the liquidator appointed under
section 217 –
(a) The liquidator of the company must immediately apply to the Court
for the appointment of that person as liquidator; and
(b) The Court may, if it thinks fit, appoint that person as the liquidator
of the company.
414 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

241 Effect of directors’ resolving company able to pay its debts

Nothing in sections 237 to 240 applies to the liquidator of a company
appointed under sections 214 or 215 if, within 20 working days before the
appointment of the liquidator, the directors of the company resolved that the
company would, on the appointment of a liquidator under either of those sections,
be able to pay its debts and a copy of the resolution is delivered to the Registrar
for registration.

242 Other creditors’ meetings

(1) Subject to section 243, the liquidator of a company who was not, by
reason of section 237, required to call a meeting of creditors of the company, must
immediately call a meeting of the creditors of the company for the purpose specified
in section 239(1)(a) or (b), if the liquidator is satisfied that –
(a) The directors who voted in favour of a resolution referred to in that
subsection did not have reasonable grounds to believe that the
company would, on the appointment of a liquidator under section
214 or 215, be able to pay its debts; or
(b) The company is not able to pay its debts.
(2) Section 239 applies with the necessary modifications.

243 Liquidator may dispense with meetings of creditors

(1) A liquidator is not required to call a meeting of creditors under sections
237 or 242, as the case may be, if –
(a) The liquidator considers that no such meeting should be held,
having regard to –
(i) the assets and liabilities of the company; and
(ii) the likely result of the liquidation of the company; and
(iii) any other relevant matters; and
(b) The liquidator gives notice in writing to the creditors stating –
(i) that the liquidator does not consider that a meeting should be
held; and
(ii) the reasons for the liquidator ’s view; and
(iii) that no such meeting will be called unless a creditor gives notice
in writing to the liquidator, within 10 working days after
receiving the notice, requesting a meeting to be called and
giving reasons why a meeting should be called; and
(c) No notice requesting a meeting to be called is received by the
liquidator within that period or, if a notice requesting a meeting to
be called is received within that period, the Court directs the
liquidator that, having regard to the reasons given in the notice
and the circumstances of the company considered by the liquidator
under paragraph (a), it is not necessary for the liquidator to call a
meeting.
(2) Notice under subsection (1)(b) must be given to every known creditor –
(a) If section 244(1) applies, together with the report and notice referred
to in that section; or
(b) If section 244(1) is not applicable, at the time the liquidator would
have been required to send the report and notice referred to in that
section if it were applicable.

Companies Act 2006

415

244 Meetings of creditors or shareholders

(1) At any time in the course of the liquidation, the liquidator may, at the
request in writing of any creditor or shareholder or on the liquidator ’s own motion,
call a meeting of creditors or shareholders –
(a) To vote on a proposal that a liquidation committee be appointed to
act with the liquidator in accordance with Schedule 16; and
(b) If it is so decided, to choose the members of the committee.
(2) A liquidator may decline a request by a creditor or shareholder to call a
meeting on the ground that –
(a) The request is frivolous or vexatious; or
(b) The request was not made in good faith; or
(c) Except if a creditor or shareholder agrees to meet the costs, the costs
of calling a meeting would be out of all proportion to the value of
the company’s assets.
(3) The decision of a liquidator to decline the request may be reviewed by
the Court on the application of any creditor or shareholder, as the case may be.
(4) Subject to subsections (2) and (3), a liquidator who receives a request to
call –
(a) A meeting of creditors must immediately call a meeting in accordance with Schedule 12; or
(b) A meeting of shareholders, must immediately call a meeting in accordance with the company’s rules, except the liquidator has power to give notice of a meeting of shareholders and to act as, or appoint, the chairperson of the meeting.
(5) The sole shareholder of a company may present to the liquidator a view
on any matter that could have been decided at a meeting of shareholders under this section, and that view must, for all purposes, be treated as though it were a decision taken at a meeting of shareholders.

245 Views of creditors and shareholders at meetings to be considered

(1) The liquidator must consider the views of –
(a) Creditors set out in a resolution passed at a meeting convened under
subpart 1 at which a resolution under section 188(1)(c) to appoint a
liquidator is passed;
(b) The shareholders by whom any special resolution was passed at a
meeting held for the purposes of section 215 set out in a resolution
passed at that meeting;
(c) Creditors set out in any resolution passed at a meeting held for the
purposes of section 239;
(d) Creditors or shareholders set out in a resolution passed at a meeting
called in accordance with subsection (2);
(e) Any liquidation committee given in writing to the liquidator.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), a liquidator –
(a) Must summon meetings of shareholders at such times as may be
specified by any resolution of shareholders passed at a meeting
held for the purposes of section 215;
(b) Must summon meetings of creditors at any times that may be
specified by any resolution of creditors passed at a meeting held
for the purposes of subpart 1 or section 239;
(c) Must summon a meeting of shareholders immediately when
required to do so by notice in writing given by shareholders holding
not less than 10% of all shares issued by the company;
416 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) Must summon a meeting of creditors immediately when required to do so by notice in writing given by creditors to whom is owed not less than 10% of the total amount owed to all creditors of the company;
(e) May, at his or her discretion, summon a meeting of shareholders or creditors of the company.
(3) A liquidator who calls a meeting of creditors or shareholders must call a meeting –
(a) In accordance with the rules of the company, in the case of a meeting
of shareholders; or
(b) In accordance with Schedule 12, in the case of a meeting of creditors.
(4) For the purposes of holding a meeting of shareholders under subsection
(3)(a), the liquidator is deemed to have power under the company’s rules to call a
meeting of shareholders despite anything in the company’s rules, and references
in the company’s rules to chairman or chairperson must be read as references to
the liquidator.
(5) Nothing in this section limits or prevents a liquidator from exercising
his or her discretion in carrying out his or her functions and duties under this Act.

246 First report

Reports

(1) A liquidator must, within the applicable period –
(a) Prepare a list of every known creditor of the company; and
(b) Prepare and send to every known creditor, every shareholder, and
the Registrar for registration –
(i) a report containing a statement of the company’s affairs,
proposals for conducting the liquidation, and, if practicable,
the estimated date of its completion; and
(ii) a notice explaining the right of a creditor or shareholder to
require the liquidator to call a meeting of creditors or
shareholders (as the case may be) under section 244.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), applicable period means –
(a) In the case of a liquidator appointed under sections 214, 215, or
216, 5 working days after the liquidator ’s appointment; or
(b) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 217, 25 working
days after the liquidator ’s appointment; or
(c) In either case, any longer period that the Court may allow.

247 Six-monthly report

A liquidator must, within 2 months of the end of each period of 6 months
following the date of commencement of the liquidation, prepare and send to every
known creditor and every shareholder, and send or deliver to the Registrar, a
report –
(a) On the conduct of the liquidation during the preceding 6 months;
and
(b) Of any further proposals that the liquidator has for completing the
liquidation.

248 Exemption from reporting requirements

(1) The Court may, on the application of a liquidator and on any conditions
that the Court thinks fit –
(a) Exempt the liquidator from compliance with sections 246 or 247; or
(b) Modify the application of those sections in relation to the liquidator.

Companies Act 2006

417
(2) The liquidator need not comply with sections 246 or 247 if the liquidator is satisfied that the value of the assets of the company available for distribution to unsecured creditors who are not preferential creditors is not likely to exceed $0.20, or any other prescribed sum, in every dollar owed to those creditors.
(3) If subsection (2) applies, and the liquidator does not intend to comply with sections 246 or 247, the liquidator must give notice to the Registrar that he or she does not intend to comply with those sections.

249 Preferential claims

Creditors’ claims

(1) The liquidator must pay out of the assets of the company the expenses, fees, and claims set out in Part 3 of Schedule 18 to the extent and in the order of priority specified in that schedule.
(2) Without limiting clause 18 of Schedule 18, assets in subsection (1) does not include assets subject to a charge unless the charge is surrendered or taken to be surrendered or redeemed under Part 2 of that schedule.

250 Claims of other creditors and distribution of surplus assets

(1) After paying preferential claims in accordance with section 249, the
liquidator must apply the assets of the company in satisfaction of all other claims.
(2) The claims referred to in subsection (1) rank equally among themselves
and must be paid in full, unless the assets are insufficient to meet them, in which
case payment abates rateably among all claims.
(3) If, before the commencement of a liquidation, a creditor agrees to accept
a lower priority in respect of a debt than that which it would otherwise have
under this section, nothing in this section prevents the agreement from having
effect according to its terms.
(4) A person whose shares have been repurchased by the company, or a
person whose shares have been redeemed by the company, but who has not
received payment in full of the repurchase price or redemption price (as the case
may be) is taken to have agreed to subordinate his or her claim for any unpaid
balance of the repurchase price or redemption price (as the case may be) to the
rights of other creditors of the company.
(5) Subject to clause 25 of Schedule 18, after paying the claims referred to
in subsections (1) and (3), the liquidator must distribute the company’s surplus
assets –
(a) In accordance with the company’s rules; or
(b) If the company’s rules do not provide for the distribution of surplus
assets, in accordance with section 23(1)(c) and any preferential rights
as to distributions of capital attached to shares issued by the
company in accordance with section 23(3)(d).

End of liquidation

251 Completion of liquidation

The liquidation of a company is completed when the liquidator –
(a) Complies with section 252(2); or
(b) Delivers to the Registrar for registration –
(i) a copy of any order made by the Court under section 252(3)(a);
or
(ii) a copy of any order made by the Court under section 252(3)(b)
together with any documents required to comply with the order.
418 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

252 Final report and accounts

(1) As soon as practicable after completing his or her duties in relation to
the liquidation, the liquidator of a company must prepare and send to every
creditor whose claim has been admitted and to every shareholder –
(a) The final report and statement of realisation and distribution in
respect of the liquidation; and
(b) A statement that –
(i) all known assets have been disclaimed, or realised, or
distributed without realisation; and
(ii) all proceeds of realisation have been distributed; and
(iii) the company is ready to be removed from the Niue register;
and
(c) A summary of the applicable grounds on which the creditor or
shareholder may object to the removal of the company from the
Niue register under section 261.
(2) As soon as practicable after completing his or her duties in relation to
the liquidation, the liquidator of a company must send or deliver copies of the
documents referred to in subsection (1) to the Registrar for registration.
(3) The Court may, on the application of a liquidator and on any conditions
that the Court thinks fit –
(a) Exempt the liquidator from compliance with subsections (1) or (2);
or
(b) Modify the application of those provisions in relation to the
liquidator.

253 Liquidation surplus account

(1) Money representing unclaimed assets of a company standing to the
credit of a liquidator must, after completion of the liquidation, be paid to the
Registrar to be held on trust and dealt with in accordance with this section.
(2) At the expiration of a period of 12 months after the date on which the
money is paid, the Registrar must, after deduction of any amount required to
meet the claim of any person that is established within that period, pay the balance
into an account entitled the “Liquidation Surplus Account” for distribution in
accordance with this section.
(3) Money held in the Liquidation Surplus Account may be invested in
accordance with the law as to the investment of trust funds by trustees. Interest
on any investment must be distributed in accordance with this section.
(4) Money held in the Liquidation Surplus Account may be –
(a) Paid or distributed to any person entitled to payment or distribution
in the liquidation of a company any money representing the surplus
assets of which has been credited to the Liquidation Surplus
Account; or
(b) Paid, subject to such conditions as the Registrar may impose, in
meeting costs incurred in the course of liquidation of a company
for the purpose of proceedings brought by the company, including
legal or other expert advice, or the costs of any expert witness, if
the Registrar is satisfied that it is fair and reasonable for those costs
to be met out of the Liquidation Surplus Account.
(5) In making a payment under this section, the Registrar is not required
to ascertain that money or sufficient money was received on account of any
company to which the claim for payment relates.

Companies Act 2006

419

254 Termination of liquidation by Court

(1) The Court may, at any time after the appointment of a liquidator of a
company, if it is satisfied that it is just and equitable to do so, make an order
terminating the liquidation of the company.
(2) An application may be made by –
(a) The liquidator of the company; or
(b) A director of the company; or
(c) A shareholder of the company; or
(d) A creditor of the company or
(e) An administrator of the company under administration or acting
under a compromise approved by a resolution of creditors in
accordance with section 188(1)(a); or
(f) The Registrar.
(3) The Court may require the liquidator of the company to give a report
to the Court with respect to any facts or matters relevant to the application.
(4) If the Court makes an order, the company ceases to be in liquidation
and the liquidator ceases to hold office with effect on and from the making of the
order or any other date specified in the order.
(5) The Court may, on, or at any time after, making an order, make any
other order that it thinks fit in connection with the termination of the liquidation.

255 Notice of termination of liquidation

(1) The person who applied for a Court order terminating the liquidation
or the liquidator, in the case of the creditors terminating the liquidation, must,
within 10 working days after the order was made, or the resolution was passed,
(as the case may be), deliver a notice of the order, or the passing of the resolution,
to the Registrar for registration.
(2) Every person who fails to comply with subsection (1) commits an
offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

256 Effect of compromise on liquidation

Unless the Court orders otherwise under section 254, a company does not
cease to be in liquidation and the liquidator continues to hold office subject to the
terms of a compromise where –
(a) The liquidator has appointed an administrator of the company; and
(b) A compromise that binds the company and its creditors, or a class
of creditors, has been approved by a resolution of creditors in
accordance with section 188(1)(a).
PART 10
REMOVAL OF COMPANIES FROM REGISTER

257 Removal from register

A company is removed from the Niue register when a notice signed by the
Registrar stating that the company is removed from the Niue register is registered
under this Act.

258 Grounds for removal from register

Subject to section 260, the Registrar must remove a company from the Niue
register if –
(a) The Registrar is satisfied that –
(i) the company has ceased to carry on business; and
(ii) there is no other reason for the company to continue in
existence; or
420 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) The company has been put into liquidation, and – (i) no liquidator is acting; or
(ii) the prescribed documents confirming that the liquidation of the company has been completed have not been sent or delivered to the Registrar within 6 months after the completion of the liquidation; or
(c) There is sent or delivered to the Registrar a request that the company be removed from the Niue register on either of the grounds specified in section 259(1) made by –
(i) a shareholder or any other person authorised to make the request by a special resolution of shareholders entitled to vote and voting on the question; or
(ii) a director or any other person, if the rules of the company so require or permit; or
(d) A liquidator sends or delivers to the Registrar the prescribed
documents confirming that the liquidation of the company has been
completed.

259 Request for company to be removed from register

(1) A request that a company be removed from the Niue register under
section 258(c) may be made on the grounds that the company –
(a) Has ceased to carry on business, has discharged in full its liabilities
to all its known creditors, and has distributed its surplus assets in
accordance with its rules and this Act; or
(b) Has no surplus assets after paying its debts in full or in part, and
no creditor has applied to the Court for an order putting the
company into liquidation.
(2) A request that a company be removed from the Niue register under
section 258(c) must be accompanied by a written notice from the Financial Secretary
stating that the Financial Secretary has no objection to the company being removed
from the Niue register.

260 Requirements to be met before company must be removed from register

(1) The Registrar must remove a company from the Niue register under
section 258(a) only if –
(a) The Registrar has complied with sections 261 and 262; and
(b) The company has not satisfied the Registrar that it is carrying on
business or that reason exists for the company to continue in
existence; and
(c) The Registrar –
(i) is satisfied that no person has objected to the removal under
section 264; or
(ii) if an objection to the removal has been received, has complied
with section 265.
(2) The Registrar must remove a company from the Niue register under
section 258(b), (c), or (d), only if –
(a) The Registrar is satisfied that notice has been given in accordance
with section 263; and
(b) The Registrar –
(i) is satisfied that no person has objected to the removal under
section 264; or
(ii) if an objection to the removal has been received, has complied
with section 265.

Companies Act 2006

421
NOTICES

261 Notice of intention to remove company that has ceased to carry on

business

Before a company can be removed from the Niue register under section
258(a), the Registrar must –
(a) Give notice to the company in accordance with section 262(1); and
(b) Give notice of the matters set out in section 262(2) to any person
who is entitled to a registered charge in respect of property of the
company; and
(c) Give public notice of the matters set out in section 262(2).

262 Contents of notice

(1) The notice to be given under section 261(a) must –
(a) State the section under, and the grounds on which, it is intended to
remove the company from the Niue register; and
(b) State that the company will be removed from the Niue register
unless –
(i) by the date specified in the notice, which must not be less than
20 working days after the date of the notice, the company
satisfies the Registrar by notice in writing that it is still carrying
on business or there is other reason for it to continue in
existence; or
(ii) the Registrar does not, in accordance with section 265, proceed
to remove the company from the Niue register.
(2) The notice to be given under section 261(b) and (c) must specify –
(a) The name of the company; and
(b) The section under which, and the grounds on which, it is intended
to remove the company from the Niue register; and
(c) The date by which an objection to the removal must be delivered to
the Registrar, which must not be less than 20 working days after
the date of the notice.

263 Notice of intention to remove in other cases

(1) If a company is to be removed from the Niue register under section
258(b), the Registrar must give public notice of the matters set out in subsection
(4).
(2) If a company is to be removed from the Niue register under section
258(c) or (d), the applicant, or the liquidator, as the case may be, must give public
notice of the matters set out in subsection (4).
(3) If a company is to be removed from the Niue register under section
258(b), the Registrar, or, if it is to be removed from the Niue register under section
258(c), the applicant, as the case may be, must also give notice of the matters set
out in subsection (4) to –
(a) The company; and
(b) A person who is entitled to a registered charge in respect of property
of the company.
(4) The notice to be given under this section must specify –
(a) The name of the company; and
(b) The section under which, and the grounds on which, it is intended
to remove the company from the Niue register; and
(c) The date by which an objection to the removal under section 266
must be delivered to the Registrar, which must be not less than 20
working days after the date of the notice.
422 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Objections

264 Objection to removal from Niue register

(1) If a notice is given of an intention to remove a company from the Niue
register, any person may deliver to the Registrar, not later than the date specified
in the notice, an objection to the removal on any 1 or more of the following
grounds –
(a) That the company is still carrying on business or there is other reason for it to continue in existence;
(b) That the company is a party to legal proceedings;
(c) That the company is in receivership, or liquidation, or both;
(d) That the person is a creditor, or a shareholder, or a person who has
an undischarged claim against the company;
(e) That the person believes that there exists, and intends to pursue, a
right of action on behalf of the company under Part 6;
(f) That, for any other reason, it would not be just and equitable to
remove the company from the Niue register.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1)(d) –
(a) A claim by a creditor against a company is not an undischarged
claim if –
(i) the claim has been paid in full; or
(ii) the claim has been paid in part under a compromise entered
into under subpart 2 of Part 9 or by being otherwise
compounded to the reasonable satisfaction of the creditor; or
(iii) the claim has been paid in full or in part by a receiver or a
liquidator in the course of a completed receivership or
liquidation; or
(iv) a receiver or a liquidator has notified the creditor that the assets
of the company are not sufficient to enable any payment to be
made to the creditor; and
(b) A claim by a shareholder or any other person against a company is
not an undischarged claim if –
(i) payment has been made to the shareholder or that person in
accordance with a right under the company’s rules to receive
or share in the company’s surplus assets; or
(ii) a receiver or liquidator has notified the shareholder or that
person that the company has no surplus assets.

265 Duties of Registrar if objection received

(1) If an objection to the removal of a company from the Niue register is
made on a ground specified in section 264(1)(a), (b), or (c), the Registrar must not
proceed with the removal unless the Registrar is satisfied that –
(a) The objection has been withdrawn; or
(b) Any facts on which the objection is based are not, or are no longer,
correct; or
(c) The objection is frivolous or vexatious.
(2) If an objection to the removal of a company from the Niue register is
made on a ground specified in section 264(1)(d), (e), or (f), the Registrar must give
notice to the person objecting that the Registrar intends to proceed with the
removal, unless notice of an application to the Court by that person for an order –
(a) That the company be put into liquidation; or
(b) Under section 266, that, on any ground specified in section 264, the
company not be removed from the Niue register –

Companies Act 2006

423
is served on the Registrar not later than 20 working days after the date of the notice.
(3) The Registrar must proceed with the removal if –
(a) Notice of such an application to the Court is not served on the
Registrar; or
(b) The application is withdrawn; or
(c) On the hearing of such an application, the Court refuses to grant
either an order putting the company into liquidation or an order
that the company not be removed from the Niue register.
(4) Every person who makes such an application must give the Registrar
notice in writing of the decision of the Court within 5 working days of the decision
being given.
(5) The Registrar must send to a person who sent or delivered to the
Registrar a request that the company be removed from the Niue register under
section 258(c) or, while acting as liquidator, sent or delivered to the Registrar the
documents referred to in section 258(d) –
(a) A copy of an objection under section 264; and
(b) A copy of a notice given by or served on the Registrar under this
section; and
(c) If the company is removed from the Niue register, notice of the
removal.

266 Powers of Court

(1) A person who gives a notice objecting to the removal of a company
from the Niue register on a ground specified in section 264(1)(d), (e), or (f) may
apply to the Court for an order that the company not be removed from the Niue
register on any ground set out in that subsection.
(2) On an application for an order under subsection (1), the Court may
make an order that the company is not to be removed from the Niue register if the
Court is satisfied that the company should not be removed from the Niue register
on any of those grounds.

Effect of removal from register

267 Property of company removed from register

(1) Property that, immediately before the removal of a company from the
Niue register, had not been distributed or disclaimed, vests in the Government
with effect from the removal of the company from the Niue register.
(2) For the purposes of this section, property of the former company –
(a) Includes leasehold property and all other rights vested in or held
on trust for the former company; but
(b) Does not include property held by the former company on trust for
any other person.
(3) The Financial Secretary must, immediately on becoming aware of the
vesting of the property, give public notice of the vesting, setting out the name of
the former company and details of the property.
(4) If property is vested in the Government under this section, a person
who would have been entitled to receive all or part of the property, or payment
from the proceeds of its realisation, if it had been in the hands of the company
immediately before the removal of the company from the Niue register, or any
other person claiming through that person, may apply to the Court for an order –
(a) Vesting all or part of the property in that person; or
(b) For payment to that person by the Government of compensation of
an amount not greater than the value of the property.
424 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(5) On an application made under subsection (4), the Court may –
(a) Decide any question concerning the value of the property, the
entitlement of any applicant to the property or to compensation,
and the apportionment of the property or compensation among 2
or more applicants; or
(b) Order that the hearing of 2 or more applications be consolidated;
or
(c) Order that an application be treated as an application on behalf of
all persons, or all members of a class of persons, with an interest in
the property; or
(d) Make an ancillary order.
(6) Compensation ordered to be paid under subsection (4) must be paid
out of the Niue Government Account without further appropriation than this
section.

268 Disclaimer of property by Government

(1) The Financial Secretary may, by notice in writing, disclaim the
Government’s title to property vesting in the Government if the property is onerous
property.
(2) The Financial Secretary must immediately give public notice of the
disclaimer.
(3) Property that is disclaimed under this section is deemed not to have
vested in the Government.
(4) Subject to any order of the Court, the Financial Secretary is not entitled
to disclaim property unless –
(a) The property is disclaimed within 12 months after the vesting of
the property in the Government first comes to the notice of the
Financial Secretary; or
(b) If before the expiry of that 12 month period, any person gives notice
in writing to the Financial Secretary requiring the Financial Secretary
to elect, before the close of such date as is stated in the notice, not
being a date that is less than 60 working days after the date on
which the notice is received by the Financial Secretary, whether to
disclaim the property, the property is disclaimed before the close of
that date.
(5) A statement in a notice disclaiming property under this section that the
vesting of the property in the Government first came to the notice of the Financial
Secretary on a specified date is, in the absence of proof to the contrary, evidence of
the fact stated.
(6) For the purposes of this section, onerous property means –
(a) An unprofitable contract; or
(b) Property of the company that is unsaleable, or not readily saleable,
or which may give rise to a liability to pay money or perform an
onerous act.

269 Effect of disclaimer

(1) A disclaimer under section 268 –
(a) Brings to an end on and from the date of the disclaimer the rights,
interests, and liabilities of the Government in relation to the property
disclaimed; and
(b) Does not, except so far as necessary to release the Government from
a liability, affect the rights or liabilities of any other person.

Companies Act 2006

425
(2) A person suffering loss or damage as a result of a disclaimer under section 268 may –
(a) Claim as a creditor of the company for the amount of the loss or damage, taking account of the effect of any order made by the Court under paragraph (b); or
(b) Apply to the Court for an order that the disclaimed property be
delivered to or vested in that person.
(3) The Court may make an order under subsection (2)(b) if it is satisfied
that it is just that the property should be vested in the applicant.

270 Liability of directors, shareholders, and others to continue

The removal of a company from the Niue register does not affect the liability
of any former director or shareholder of the company or any other person in respect
of any act or omission that took place before the company was removed from the
Niue register and that liability continues and may be enforced as if the company
had not been removed from the Niue register.

271 Liquidation of company removed from Niue register

(1) Despite the fact that a company has been removed from the Niue
register, the Court may appoint a liquidator of the company as if the company
continued in existence.
(2) If a liquidator is appointed in accordance with subsection (1) –
(a) Subpart 3 of Part 9 applies, with the necessary modifications, to the
liquidation;
(b) Section 278 applies, with the necessary modifications, to property
of the company that is vested in the Government as if the company
had been restored to the Niue register.

Restoration of removed company to Niue register

272 Registrar may restore company to Niue register

(1) Subject to sections 273 and 274, the Registrar must, on the application
of a person referred to in subsection (2), and may, on his or her own motion, restore
a company that has been removed from the Niue register to the Niue register if he
or she is satisfied that, at the time the company was removed from the Niue
register –
(a) The company was still carrying on business or other reason existed for the company to continue in existence; or
(b) The company was a party to legal proceedings; or
(c) The company was in receivership, or liquidation, or administration.
(2) Any person may apply under subsection (1) if the person was, at the
time the company was removed from the Niue register –
(a) A shareholder or director of the company; or
(b) A creditor of the company; or
(c) An administrator, a liquidator, or a receiver of the property, of the
company.
(3) Nothing in this section or sections 273 to 275 limits or affects section
276.

273 Requirements to be met before restoring company to Niue register

(1) Before the Registrar restores a company to the Niue register –
(a) In the case of a company that was removed from the Niue register
under section 258(a) or (b), the Registrar must give public notice
setting out –
426 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(i) the name of the company; and
(ii) the name and address of the applicant; and
(iii) the section under, and the grounds on which, the application is
made or the Registrar proposes to act, as the case may be; and
(iv) the date by which an objection to restoring the company to the
Niue register must be delivered to the Registrar, not being less
than 20 working days after the date of the notice; and
(b) In the case of a company that was removed from the Niue register
under section 258(c) or (d), the person who made the application
under section 272(1) must give public notice setting out –
(i) The name of the company; and
(ii) the person’s name and address; and
(iii) the section under which, and the grounds on which, the
application is made; and
(iv) the date by which an objection to restoring the company to the
Niue register must be delivered to the Registrar, not being less
than 20 working days after the date of the notice.
(2) Before the Registrar restores a company to the Niue register, the
Registrar may require any of the provisions of this Act or any other Act or any
regulations made under this Act or any other Act, being provisions with which
the company had failed to comply before it was removed from the Niue register,
to be complied with.

274 Registrar not to restore company to Niue register if objection received

The Registrar must not restore a company to the Niue register if the Registrar
receives an objection to the restoration within the period stated in the notice.

275 Court directions

The Court may, on the application of the Registrar or the applicant, give
any directions or make any orders that may be necessary or desirable for the
purpose of placing a company that is restored to the Niue register under section
272 and any other persons as nearly as possible in the same position as if the
company had not been removed from the register.

276 Court may restore company to Niue register

(1) The Court may, on the application of a person referred to in subsection
(2), order that a company that has been removed from the Niue register be restored
to the Niue register if it is satisfied that –
(a) At the time the company was removed from the Niue register –
(i) the company was still carrying on business or other reason
existed for the company to continue in existence; or
(ii) the company was a party to legal proceedings; or
(iii) the company was in receivership, or liquidation, or
administration; or
(iv) the applicant was a creditor, or a shareholder, or a person who
had an undischarged claim against the company; or
(v) the applicant believed that a right of action existed, or intended
to pursue a right of action, on behalf of the company under
Part 6; or
(b) For any other reason it is just and equitable to restore the company
to the Niue register.

Companies Act 2006

427
(2) The following persons may make an application under subsection (1) – (a) Any person who, at the time the company was removed from the
Niue register –
(i) Was a shareholder or director of the company; or
(ii) was a creditor of the company; or
(iii) was a party to any legal proceedings against the company; or
(iv) had an undischarged claim against the company; or
(v) was the administrator, or liquidator, or a receiver of the property
of, the company;
(b) The Registrar;
(c) With the leave of the Court, any other person.
(3) Before the Court makes an order restoring a company to the Niue
register under this section, it may require any provisions of this Act or any other
Act or any regulations made under this Act or under any other Act, being provisions
with which the company had failed to comply before it was removed from the
Niue register, to be complied with.
(4) The Court may give any directions or make any orders that may be
necessary or desirable for the purpose of placing the company and any other
persons as nearly as possible in the same position as if the company had not been
removed from the Niue register.

277 Restoration to register

(1) A company is restored to the Niue register when a notice signed by the
Registrar stating that the company is restored to the Niue register is registered
under this Act.
(2) A company that is restored to the Niue register is deemed to have
continued in existence as if it had not been removed from the register.

278 Vesting of property in company on restoration to register

(1) Subject to this section, property of a company that is, at the time the
company is restored to the Niue register, vested in the Government pursuant to
section 267, vests in the company on its restoration to the Niue register as if the
company had not been removed from the Niue register.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) applies to any property vested in the
Government under section 267 if the Court has made an order for the payment of
compensation to any person under section 267(4)(b) in respect of that property.
(3) Nothing in subsection (1) applies to land or any estate or interest in
land that has vested in the Government if transmission to the Government of the
land or that estate or interest in land has been registered under the Land Act 1969.
(4) If transmission to the Government of land or any estate or interest in
land that has vested in the Government under section 267 has been registered
under the Land Act 1969, the Court may, on the application of the company, make
an order –
(a) For the transfer of the land or the estate or interest to the company;
or
(b) For the payment by the Government to the company of
compensation –
(i) Of an amount not greater than the value of the land or the estate
or interest as at the date of registration of the transmission; or
428 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(ii) if the land or the estate or interest has been sold or contracted to be sold, of an amount equal to the net amount received or receivable from the sale.
(5) On an application under subsection (4), the Court may decide any question concerning the value of the land or the estate or interest.
(6) Compensation ordered to be paid under subsection (4) must be paid
out of the Niue Government Account without further appropriation than this
section.
PART 11
OVERSEAS COMPANIES

279 Meaning of carrying on business

For the purposes of this Part –
(a) A reference to an overseas company carrying on business in Niue
includes a reference to the overseas company –
(i) establishing or using a share transfer office or a share
registration office in Niue; or
(ii) administering, managing, or dealing with property in Niue as
an agent, or personal representative, or trustee, and whether
through its employees or an agent or in any other manner;
(b) An overseas company does not carry on business in Niue merely
because in Niue it –
(i) Is or becomes a party to a legal proceeding or settles a legal
proceeding or a claim or dispute; or
(ii) holds meetings of its directors or shareholders or carries on
other activities concerning its internal affairs; or
(iii) maintains a bank account; or
(iv) effects a sale of property through an independent contractor;
or
(v) solicits or procures an order that becomes a binding contract
only if the order is accepted outside Niue; or
(vi) creates evidence of a debt or creates a charge on property; or
(vii) secures or collects any of its debts or enforces its rights in
relation to securities relating to those debts; or
(viii) conducts an isolated transaction that is completed within a
period of 30 working days, not being one of a number of similar
transactions repeated from time to time; or
(ix) invests its funds or holds property.

280 Name must comply with section 10

(1) An overseas company must not carry on business in Niue on or after
the commencement of this Act under a name that could not be registered under
section 10.
(2) If an overseas company contravenes this section –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

Companies Act 2006

429

281 Overseas companies to register under this Act

(1) An overseas company that, on or after the commencement of this Act,
commences to carry on business in Niue must apply for registration under this
Part in accordance with section 283 within 20 working days of commencing to
carry on business.
(2) An overseas company that, immediately before the commencement of
this Act, was carrying on business in Niue and, on the commencement of this Act,
continues to carry on business in Niue, must apply for registration under this Part
in accordance with section 283 within 40 working days of the commencement of
this Act.
(3) An overseas company that changes its name must send or deliver to
the Registrar a notice in the prescribed form of the change of name within 10
working days of the change of name.
(4) If an overseas company fails to comply with this section –
(a) The overseas company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the overseas company commits an offence and is
liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

282 Validity of transactions not affected

A failure by an overseas company to comply with sections 280 or 281 does
not affect the validity or enforceability of any transaction entered into by the
overseas company.

283 Application for registration

(1) An application for registration of an overseas company under this Part
must be delivered to the Registrar and must be –
(a) In the prescribed form; and
(b) Signed by or on behalf of the overseas company.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), the application must –
(a) State the name of the overseas company; and
(b) State the full names and residential addresses and postal addresses
of the directors of the overseas company at the date of the
application; and
(c) State the full address of the place of business in Niue of the overseas
company or, if the overseas company has more than 1 place of
business in Niue, the full address of the principal place of business
in Niue of the overseas company; and
(d) State the postal address in Niue of the overseas company; and
(e) Have attached evidence of incorporation of the overseas company,
and, if not in English, a certified translation of that document; and
(f) State the full name of 1 or more persons resident or incorporated in
Niue who are authorised to accept service in Niue of documents
on behalf of the overseas company, and the postal address and
residential or business address of each those persons.
430 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

284 Registration of overseas company

(1) If the Registrar receives a properly completed application for
registration under this Part of an overseas company, the Registrar must
immediately register the overseas company on the overseas register.
(2) If an overseas company is deemed to be registered under this Part, the
Registrar must, immediately after the commencement of this Act, transfer the
registration of the overseas company to the overseas register.
(3) If the Registrar receives a notice of a change of name of an overseas
company in accordance with section 281(5), the Registrar must register the change
of name on the overseas register.

285 Use of name by overseas company

(1) Every overseas company that carries on business in Niue must ensure
that its full name, and the name of the country where it was incorporated, are
clearly stated in –
(a) Written communications sent by, or on behalf of, the company; and
(b) Documents issued or signed by, or on behalf of, the company that
evidence or create a legal obligation of the company.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), a generally recognised abbreviation
of a word or words may be used in the name of an overseas company if it is not
misleading to do so.

286 Further information to be provided by overseas company

(1) An overseas company that carries on business in Niue must ensure
that, within 20 working days of the change, notice in the prescribed form is given
to the Registrar of –
(a) A change in the directors or in the names or residential addresses
or postal addresses of the directors of the overseas company; or
(b) A change in the address of the place of business or principal place
of business of the overseas company; or
(c) A change in the postal address in Niue of the overseas company; or
(d) A change in any person or in the postal address or residential or
business address of any person authorised to accept service in Niue
of documents on behalf of the overseas company.
(2) An overseas company must, within 20 working days of being required
to do so by the Registrar, deliver to the Registrar –
(a) A certified copy of the document constituting or defining its
constitution; or
(b) A certified copy of any alterations to that document since a copy of
the document was last provided to the Registrar; and
(c) If the relevant documents are not in English, a certified translation
of those documents. The Registrar must require delivery of the
relevant documents by the overseas company under this subsection
if requested to do so by any creditor of that overseas company in
Niue, unless the Registrar considers that the request is frivolous or
vexatious.
(3) If an overseas company fails to comply with subsections (1) or (2) –
(a) The overseas company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the overseas company commits an offence and is
liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

Companies Act 2006

431

287 Annual return of overseas company

(1) Every overseas company that carries on business in Niue must ensure
that the Registrar receives each year, during the month allocated to the overseas
company for the purposes of this section, an annual return in the prescribed form
confirming that the information on the overseas register in respect of the overseas
company referred to in the return is correct at the date of the return.
(2) The annual return must be dated as at a day within the month during
which the return is required to be received by the Registrar.
(3) On registration of an overseas company under this Part, the Registrar
must allocate a month to the company for the purposes of this section.
(4) The Registrar may, by written notice to an overseas company, alter the
month allocated to the company under subsection (3).
(5) Despite subsection (1), an overseas company that is deemed to be
registered under this Part need not make an annual return in the calendar year of
its registration under this Part.
(6) If an overseas company fails to comply with subsections (1) or (2) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the overseas company commits an offence and is
liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

288 Overseas company ceasing to carry on business in Niue

(1) An overseas company registered under this Part that intends to cease
to carry on business in Niue must –
(a) Give public notice of that intention; and
(b) Give notice to the Registrar in the prescribed form stating the date
on which it will cease to carry on business in Niue.
(2) The Registrar must remove an overseas company from the overseas
register as soon as practicable after –
(a) The date specified in the notice given in accordance with subsection
(1)(b); or
(b) Receipt of a written notice given by a liquidator that the liquidation
of the assets in Niue of the overseas company has been completed.

289 Attorneys of overseas companies

(1) Part XII of the Property Law Act 1952 applies, with the necessary
modifications, to a power of attorney executed by an overseas company registered
under this Part to the same extent as if the company were a person and as if the
commencement of the liquidation of the company was the death of a person within
the meaning of Part XII of that Act.
(2) A declaration endorsed on or annexed to a document appointing, or
appearing to appoint, an attorney of an overseas company, made or appearing to
be made by one of the directors before a person authorised by section 76 of the
Niue Act 1966 to take an affidavit for use in Niue, in the country concerned, to the
effect that –
(a) The company is incorporated under the name stated in the
document in accordance with the law of the country in which it is
so incorporated, the name of which is stated in the declaration; and
(b) The document has been executed, and the powers appearing to be
conferred on the attorney are authorised to be conferred under the
constitution of the company, or under the Act or document under
which the company is incorporated, or by any other document
constituting or defining the constitution of the company; and
432 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) The person making the declaration is a director of the company –
is conclusive evidence of those facts.

290 Liquidation of assets in Niue

(1) An application may be made to the Court for the liquidation of the
assets in Niue of an overseas company in accordance with subpart 3 of Part 9,
subject to the modifications and exclusions set out in Schedule 19.
(2) An application may be made under subsection (1) whether or not the
overseas company –
(a) Is registered under this Part; or
(b) Has given public notice of an intention to cease to carry on business
in Niue; or
(c) Has given notice to the Registrar of the date on which it will cease
to carry on business in Niue; or
(d) Has been dissolved, or otherwise ceased to exist as a company, under
or by virtue of the laws of any other country.

291 Exemption from requirements of this Part

Regulations may be made providing for any class or classes of overseas
company to be exempted from the application of any or all of the requirements of
this Part, or modifying the application of this Part to such overseas companies, on
such terms and conditions as may be prescribed in those regulations.
PART 12
TRANSFER OF REGISTRATION

292 Overseas companies may be registered as companies under this Act

Subject to this Part, an overseas company may be registered as a company
under this Act.

293 Application for registration

(1) An application by an overseas company to register as a company under
this Act must be in the prescribed form and must be accompanied by –
(a) A certified copy of its certificate of incorporation or other similar
document that evidences its incorporation; and
(b) A certified copy of its rules or other similar document; and
(c) Evidence acceptable to the Registrar that the company is not
prevented from being registered as a company under this Act by
either sections 294 or 295; and
(d) The documents and information that are required to register a
company under this Act; and
(e) Any other documents and information the Registrar may require.
(2) The Registrar may direct that a document that has been delivered to
the Registrar or registered under Part 11 need not accompany the application.

294 Overseas companies must be authorised to register

An overseas company must not be registered as a company under this Act
unless –
(a) The company is authorised to transfer its incorporation under the law of the country in which it is incorporated; and
(b) The company has complied with the requirements of that law in
relation to the transfer of its incorporation; and

Companies Act 2006

433
(c) If that law does not require its shareholders, or a specified proportion of them, to consent to the transfer of its incorporation, the transfer has been consented to by not less than 75% of its shareholders entitled to vote and voting in person or by proxy at a meeting of which not less than 15 working days’ notice is given specifying the intention to transfer the company’s incorporation.

295 Overseas companies that cannot be registered

An overseas company must not be registered as a company under this Act
if –
(a) The company is in liquidation; or
(b) A receiver or manager has been appointed, whether by a Court or
not, in relation to the property of the company; or
(c) The company has entered into a compromise or arrangement with
a creditor that is in force; or
(d) An application has been made to a Court and has not been dealt
with, whether in Niue or in another country –
(i) to put the company into liquidation or to wind it up; or
(ii) For the approval of a compromise or arrangement between the
company and a creditor.

296 Registration

(1) As soon as the Registrar receives a properly completed application for
registration of an overseas company as a company under this Act, the Registrar
must –
(a) Enter the company on the Niue register; and
(b) Issue a certificate of registration in the prescribed form.
(2) A certificate of registration of a company issued under this section is
conclusive evidence that –
(a) All the requirements as to registration have been complied with;
and
(b) On and from the date of registration stated in the certificate, the
company is registered under this Act.
(3) If an application for registration of an overseas company as a company
under this Act specifies a date on which the registration is intended to become
effective, and that date is the same as, or later than, the date on which the Registrar
receives the documents, the certificate of registration must be expressed to have
effect on the date specified in the application.

297 Effect of registration

(1) The registration of an overseas company under this Act does not –
(a) Create a new legal entity; or
(b) Prejudice or affect the identity of the body corporate constituted by
the company or its continuity as a legal entity; or
(c) Affect the property, rights, or obligations of the company; or
(d) Affect proceedings by or against the company.
(2) Proceedings that could have been commenced or continued by or
against the overseas company before registration under this Act may be
commenced or continued by or against the company after registration.
434 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

298 Companies may transfer incorporation

Subject to this Part, a company may be removed from the Niue register in
connection with becoming incorporated under the law in force in, or in any part
of, another country.

299 Application to transfer incorporation

An application by a company for removal from the Niue register in
connection with becoming incorporated under the law in force in, or in any part
of, another country must be in the prescribed form and must be accompanied
by –
(a) Evidence acceptable to the Registrar that sections 300 and 301 have been complied with; and
(b) Evidence acceptable to the Registrar that the removal of the company from the Niue register is not prevented by section 302; and
(c) Written notice from the Financial Secretary that the Financial Secretary has no objection to the company being removed from the Niue register; and
(d) Evidence acceptable to the Registrar that the company is incorporated under that law, or will be incorporated under that law no later than the date on which it is to be removed from the Niue register; and
(e) Any other documents or information that the Registrar may require.

300 Approval of shareholders

A company must not apply to be removed from the Niue register under
section 299 unless the making of the application has been approved by special
resolution.

301 Company to give public notice

(1) A company must not apply to be removed from the Niue register under
section 299 unless –
(a) The company gives public notice –
(i) stating that it intends, after the date specified in the notice,
which must not be less than 20 working days after the date of
the notice, to apply under section 299 for the company to be
removed from the Niue register in connection with the company
becoming incorporated under the law in force in, or in any part
of, another country; and
(ii) specifying the country or part of the country under the law of
that it is proposed that the company will become incorporated;
and
(b) The application is made after the date specified in the notice.
(2) If the Court is satisfied that the proposed removal of a company from
the Niue register under this Part would unfairly prejudice a shareholder or creditor
of the company or a person to whom the company is under an obligation, it may,
on the application of that person made at any time before the date on which the
removal becomes effective, make any of the following orders –
(a) An order restraining the removal of the company from the Niue
register under this Part;
(b) An order specifying conditions that must be met by the company
before being removed from the Niue register under this Part;

Companies Act 2006

435
(c) If an order is made under paragraphs (a) or (b), orders granting any consequential or ancillary relief that the Court thinks fit.

302 Companies that cannot transfer incorporation

A company must not be removed from the Niue register under section 303
if –
(a) The company is in administration or liquidation, or an application has been made to the Court to put the company into liquidation; or
(b) A receiver or manager has been appointed, whether by the Court or not, in relation to any property of the company; or
(c) A compromise has been approved by the Court under subpart 2 of Part 8 in relation to the company or an application has been made to the Court to approve a compromise under that subpart; or
(d) The company has entered into a compromise with creditors or a class of creditors under subpart 2 of Part 9 or a compromise has been proposed under that subpart in relation to the company; or
(e) An order restraining its removal from the Niue register has been made under section 301, or any conditions specified in an order made under section 301 have not been satisfied by the company.

303 Removal from register

(1) As soon as the Registrar receives a properly completed application to
remove a company from the Niue register, the Registrar must enter on the register
a notice signed by the Registrar that the company has been removed from the
Niue register in accordance with this Part.
(2) If an application for removal of a company from the Niue register under
this Part specifies a date on which the removal is intended to become effective,
and that date is the same as, or later than, the date on which the Registrar receives
the application, the notice of removal must be expressed to have effect on the date
specified in the application.

304 Effect of removal from register

(1) The removal of a company from the Niue register under section 303
does not –
(a) Prejudice or affect the identity of the body corporate that was constituted under this Act or its continuity as a legal person; or
(b) Affect the property, rights, or obligations of that body corporate; or
(c) Affect proceedings by or against that body corporate.
(2) Proceedings that could have been commenced or continued by or
against a company before the company was removed from the Niue register under
section 303 may be commenced or continued by or against the body corporate
that continues in existence after the removal of the company from the Niue register.

305 Registrar

PART 13
REGISTRAR OF COMPANIES

Subpart 1–Registrar

OFFICE
The Minister must appoint a person to hold office as Registrar of Companies.

306 Deputy Registrars

(1) The Registrar may appoint as many Deputy Registrars of Companies
as may be necessary for the purposes of this Act.
436 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) Subject to the control of the Registrar, a Deputy Registrar has and may exercise the powers, duties, and functions of the Registrar under this Act.
(3) The fact that a Deputy Registrar exercises those powers, duties, or functions is conclusive evidence of his or her authority to do so.

307 Transitional

The person holding office as Registrar of International Business Companies
under the International Business Companies Act 1994 immediately before the
commencement of this Act is deemed to have been appointed as Registrar of
Companies.

308 Notices; general

Notices by Registrar

Section 347 applies, with the necessary modifications, to the giving of notices by the Registrar.

309 Notices to individuals

(1) A notice that the Registrar is required by this Act to give to an individual,
must be given in writing and in a manner that the Registrar considers appropriate
in the circumstances.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), the Registrar may give notice to an
individual by –
(a) Having it delivered to that person; or
(b) Posting it to that person at his or her last known postal address; or
(c) Faxing it to a fax number used by that person; or
(d) Having it published in a newspaper or other publication in
circulation in the area where that person lives or is believed to live.

310 Admissibility of notices given by Registrar

A document is admissible in legal proceedings if the document –
(a) Appears to be a copy of a notice given by the Registrar; and
(b) Is certified by the Registrar, or by a person authorised by the
Registrar, as having been derived from a device or facility that
records or stores information electronically or by other means.
POWERS

311 Registrar may require information and copies of documents

(1) The Registrar may give notice to a company requiring that company to
provide, by the date specified in the notice –
(a) Corrected or updated details of any matter entered on any of the
registers for that company; or
(b) A certified copy of any document that has been or ought to have
been delivered to the Registrar for registration under this Act, or
under any other Act for that company.
(2) The date specified in the notice must not be less than 10 working days
from the date on which the notice is sent to the company.
(3) If a company fails to comply with a notice given under subsection (1) –
(a) The company commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 50 penalty units; and
(b) Every director of the company commits an offence and is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.
(4) In this section and section 312, company includes an overseas company.

Companies Act 2006

437

312 Registrar may amend registers

If information provided to the Registrar by a company under section 311
differs from the information shown on any of the registers for that company, the
Registrar may amend the registers accordingly.

313 Registrar’s powers of inspection

(1) The Registrar, or any person authorised by the Registrar, may, for the
purposes set out in subsection (2) and if the Registrar considers that it is in the
public interest to do so, do any of the following –
(a) Require a person, including a person carrying on the business of
banking, to produce for inspection relevant documents within that
person’s possession or control;
(b) Inspect and take copies of relevant documents;
(c) Take possession of relevant documents and remove them from the
place where they are kept, and retain them for a reasonable time,
for the purpose of taking copies;
(d) Retain relevant documents for a period that is, in all the
circumstances reasonable, if there are reasonable grounds for
believing that they are evidence of the commission of an offence.
(2) The purposes referred to in subsection (1) are to –
(a) Ascertain whether a company or a director of a company is
complying, or has complied, with this Act; or
(b) Ascertain whether the Registrar should exercise any of his or her
rights or powers under this Act; or
(c) Detect offences against this Act.
(3) Every person who fails to comply with subsection (1)(a) commits an
offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.
(4) In this section –
company includes an overseas company
relevant document, in relation to a company, means a document that
contains information relating to –
(a) The company; or
(b) Money or other property that is, or has been, managed, supervised,
controlled, or held in trust by or for the company.

314 Registrar not to be obstructed

(1) A person must not obstruct or hinder the Registrar, or a person
authorised by the Registrar, while exercising a power conferred by section 313.
(2) Every person who fails to comply with subsection (1) commits an
offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

315 Certain Acts not affected by Registrar’s power of inspection

Nothing in sections 313 to 314 limits or affects the Income Tax Act 1961.

316 Disclosure of information and reports

(1) A person authorised by the Registrar for the purpose of section 313
must, if directed to do so by the Registrar, give the following documents,
information, or reports to the persons described in subsection (2) –
(a) Any document or information obtained in the course of making an
inspection under that section; or
(b) Any report prepared in relation to an inspection under that section.
438 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) The persons referred to in subsection (1) are – (a) The Minister; or
(b) The Secretary; or
(c) Any person authorised by the Registrar to receive the document,
information, or report for the purposes of, or in connection with,
the exercise of powers conferred by this Act; or
(d) A liquidator for the purposes of the liquidation of a company; or
(e) Any person authorised by the Registrar to receive the document,
information, or report for the purposes of detecting or investigating
offences against any Act.
(3) Every person who fails to comply with this section commits an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

317 Information and report to be given to Registrar

(1) A person authorised by the Registrar for the purposes of section 313
must give the following documents, information, or reports to the Registrar or a
Deputy Registrar when directed to do so by any person who holds any of those
offices –
(a) Any document or information obtained in the course of making an inspection under that section; or
(b) Any report prepared in relation to an inspection under that section.
(2) Every person who fails to comply with this section commits an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

318 Restrictions on disclosing information

(1) A person authorised by the Registrar for the purposes of section 313
must not disclose any of the documents, information, or reports referred to in that
section except –
(a) In accordance with that section; or
(b) Subject to the approval of the Registrar, with the consent of the
person to whom it relates; or
(c) Subject to the approval of the Registrar, for the purposes of, or in
connection with, the exercise of powers conferred by this Act; or
(d) To the extent that the information, or information contained in the
document or report, is available under any Act or in a public
document; or
(e) Subject to the approval of the Registrar, to a liquidator for the
purposes of the liquidation of a company or the assets of an overseas
company; or
(f) In the course of criminal proceedings; or
(g) Subject to the approval of the Registrar, for the purpose of detecting
offences against any Act.
(2) Every person who fails to comply with this section commits an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

319 Inspector’s report admissible in liquidation proceedings

Despite any other Act or rule of law, a report prepared by a person in relation
to an inspection carried out by him or her under section 313 is admissible in
evidence at the hearing of an application to the Court to appoint a liquidator.

320 Appeals

Companies Act 2006

Appeals

439
(1) A person who is aggrieved by an act or decision of the Registrar under this Act may appeal to the Court within 15 working days after the date of notification of the act or decision, or within any further time that the Court may allow.
(2) On hearing the appeal, the Court may –
(a) Approve the Registrar ’s act or decision;
(b) Give any directions that the Court thinks fit;
(c) Make any determination in the matter that the Court thinks fit.

321 Exercise of inspection power not affected by appeal

Subject to section 322, but despite any other provision of any Act or any
rule of law, if a person appeals or applies to the Court in relation to an act or
decision of the Registrar or a person authorised by the Registrar under section
313, until a decision on the appeal or application is given –
(a) The Registrar, or that person, may continue to exercise the powers
under that section as if no such appeal or application had been made;
and
(b) No person is excused from fulfilling an obligation under that section
by reason of that appeal or application.

322 Destruction and admissibility of Registrar’s documents

If an appeal or application to which section 321 applies is allowed or granted,
as the case may be –
(a) The Registrar must ensure that, immediately after the decision of
the Court is given, any copy of a document taken or retained by the
Registrar, or by a person authorised by the Registrar in respect of
that act or decision, is destroyed; and
(b) No information acquired under that section in relation to that act
or decision is admissible in evidence in any proceedings unless the
Court hearing the proceedings in which it is sought to adduce the
evidence is satisfied it was not obtained unfairly.

323 Registers

Subpart 2 – Registers kept by Registrar

REGISTERS
(1) The Registrar must ensure that the following registers (registers) are kept in any place in Niue or overseas that the Registrar determines from time to time –
(a) A register of companies (Niue register); and
(b) A register of overseas companies (overseas register); and
(c) A register of charges in the prescribed form (if any) for each company
(register of charges).
(2) The registers may be kept in any manner that the Registrar thinks fit
including, either wholly or partly, by means of a device or facility –
(a) That records or stores information electronically or by other means;
and
(b) That permits the information so recorded or stored to be readily
inspected or reproduced in usable form.
440 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

324 Inspection of registers

Inspection of registers

(1) A person may, on payment of any prescribed fees, inspect –
(a) A registered document that is part of any of the registers referred to
in section 323(1) (registered document);
(b) Details of any registered document that have been entered on any
device or facility referred to in section 323(3);
(c) Any registered document of which details have been entered in
any such device or facility.
(2) The inspection must take place during the hours when the office of the
Registrar is open to the public for the transaction of business on a working day.

325 Certified copies

A person may, on payment of any fees that are prescribed, require the
Registrar to give or certify –
(a) A certificate of incorporation of a company; or
(b) A copy of, or extract from, a registered document
(c) Details of any registered document that have been entered in any
device or facility referred to in section 323(3); or
(d) A copy of, or extract from, a registered document details of which
have been entered in any such device or facility.

326 Evidence

(1) A process must not issue from the Court without the leave of the Court
to compel the production of –
(a) A registered document kept by the Registrar; or
(b) Evidence of the entry of details of a registered document in any
device or facility referred to in section 323(3).
(2) A process that issues from the Court with the leave of the Court under
subsection (1) must have on its face, or attached to it, a statement that it is issued
with the leave of the Court.
(3) A copy of, or extract from, a registered document certified to be a true
copy or extract by the Registrar is admissible in evidence in legal proceedings to
the same extent as the original document.
(4) An extract certified by the Registrar as containing details of a registered
document that have been entered in any device or facility referred to in section
323(3) is, in the absence of proof to the contrary, conclusive evidence of the entry
of those details.

327 Registration of documents

Registration

As soon as a document is received for registration under this Act, the
Registrar must –
(a) Subject to section 328, register the document in the appropriate
register; and
(b) In the case of a document that is not an annual return, give written
advice of the registration to the person from whom the document
was received.

Companies Act 2006

441

328 Rejection of documents

(1) The Registrar may refuse to register a document that –
(a) Is not in the prescribed form, if any; or
(b) Does not comply with this Act or regulations made under this Act;
or
(c) Is not printed or typewritten; or
(d) If the relevant register is kept wholly or partly by means of a device
or facility referred to in section 323(3), is not in a form that enables
details to be entered directly by electronic or other means in the
device or facility; or
(e) Has not been properly completed; or
(f) Contains material that is not clearly legible; or
(g) Is not accompanied by the prescribed fee.
(2) If subsection (1) applies, the Registrar may require either that –
(a) The document is submitted for registration again, appropriately
amended or completed, or accompanied by the prescribed fee; or
(b) A fresh document is submitted in its place.

329 When document registered

For the purposes of this Act, a document is registered when –
(a) The document itself becomes part of the register to which it relates;
or
(b) Details of the document are entered in any device or facility referred
to in section 323(3).

330 No presumption of validity or invalidity

Neither registration, nor refusal of registration, of a document by the
Registrar affects, or creates a presumption as to, the validity or invalidity of the
document or the correctness or otherwise of the information contained in it.
PART 14
REREGISTRATION OF INTERNATIONAL
BUSINESS COMPANIES

331 Period for reregistration

(1) An international business company may reregister under this Act at
any time during the transition period.
(2) In this Part, transition period means the period beginning on the date
of the commencement of this Part and ending with the close of 31 December 2006.

332 Rules of reregistered company

(1) Subject to subsections (3) and (4), on reregistration –
(a) The memorandum of association of an international business
company is deemed to form part of the articles of association of the
company; and to the extent of any inconsistency between the
memorandum of association and the articles of association of the
company, the memorandum of association prevails; and
(b) The articles of association of an international business company
(which incorporate its memorandum of association in accordance
with paragraph (a)) continue as the rules of the company for the
purposes of this Act; and
442 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) All shares issued by the international business company before reregistration are deemed to be converted into shares of no par value; but that conversion does not affect the rights and obligations attached to the shares, and, in particular, does not affect –
(i) the entitlements of the holder of the shares in respect of distributions, voting, the redemption of any redeemable shares, or the distribution of surplus assets of the company in a liquidation;
(ii) any unpaid liability of a shareholder in respect of a share.
(2) Despite anything in the articles of the international business company,
the holder of a share at the time of reregistration is personally liable for any liability
(including a liability for calls) attached to the share; and, in the event of a transfer
of the share after reregistration, that liability remains with the shareholder at the
time of reregistration, and does not pass to the transferee of the share.
(3) An international business company may resolve to adopt the model
rules in Schedules 2, 3, or 4 as its rules on reregistration under this Act.
(4) An international business company may resolve to adopt new rules
that differ from the model rules on reregistration under this Act.
(5) A resolution under subsections (3) or (4) must be approved before
reregistration in the same manner as would be required under the International
Business Companies Act 1994 and the company’s memorandum of association
and articles of association for approval of a resolution altering the company’s
articles of association.

333 Documents to be filed

(1) An application for reregistration of an international business company
under this Act must be made to the Registrar in the prescribed form.
(2) An application for reregistration of a international business company
must specify –
(a) The name of the company; and
(b) Whether the company is to be registered under this Act as a private
company or a public company; and
(c) The full name and residential address and postal address of every
director of the company; and
(d) In the case of a private company, the full name of every shareholder
of the company, and the number and class of shares held by each
shareholder; and
(e) The registered office of the company; and
(f) The postal address of the company, which may be the postal address
of the registered office or any other postal address; and
(g) Details of the location of any records of the company referred to in
section 117 that are not kept at the registered office of the company.
(3) An application for reregistration must be accompanied by –
(a) A copy of –
(i) any resolution of the company under section 332(3) or (4); and
(ii) any rules adopted by a company under section 332(4); or
(iii) certified copies of the existing memorandum of association and
articles of association of the company, if it is reregistering with
its existing constitutional documents under section 332(1); and
(b) The prescribed fee for reregistration.

Companies Act 2006

443

334 Effect of reregistration

(1) As soon as the Registrar receives an application for reregistration that
complies with section 333, the Registrar must –
(a) Enter the company on the Niue register; and
(b) Issue a certificate of reregistration in respect of the company in the
prescribed form.
(2) A certificate of reregistration of a company issued under subsection (1)
is conclusive evidence that –
(a) All the requirements as to reregistration have been complied with;
and
(b) On and from the date of reregistration stated in the certificate, the
company is registered under this Act.
(3) The reregistration of an existing company under this Act does not –
(a) Prejudice or affect the identity of the body corporate that was
constituted under the International Business Companies Act 1994
or its continuity as a legal person; or
(b) Affect the property, rights, or obligations of that body corporate; or
(c) Affect proceedings by or against that body corporate.

335 Failure to reregister

If an international business company fails to reregister before the expiry of
the transition period, the following provisions apply with effect from the expiry
of the transition period –
(a) The international business company is deemed to have been
dissolved on the last day of the transition period;
(b) The international business company may, despite the expiry of the
transition period and its deemed dissolution, reregister in
accordance with the procedures set out in this Part, and sections
276 to 278 of this Act apply with the necessary modifications as if
the company had been removed from the Niue register under this
Act.
PART 15
MISCELLANEOUS

Subpart 1 – Offences

336 Proceedings for offences

(1) Despite anything to the contrary in the Niue Act 1966, any information
for an offence under this Act may be laid at any time within 3 years after the date
of the offence.
(2) Nothing in this Act affects the liability of any person under any other
Act, but no person may be convicted of an offence against this Act and any other
Act in respect of the same conduct.

337 False statements on documents

(1) Every person commits an offence who, with respect to a document
required by or for the purposes of this Act –
(a) Makes, or authorises the making of, a statement in it that is false or
misleading in a material particular knowing it to be false or
misleading; or
(b) Omits, or authorises the omission from it of, any matter knowing
that the omission makes the document false or misleading in a
material particular.
444 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) Every director or employee of a company commits an offence who makes or provides, or authorises or permits the making or providing of, a statement or report that relates to the affairs of the company and that is false or misleading in a material particular, to –
(a) A director, employee, auditor, shareholder, debenture holder, or trustee for debenture holders of the company; or
(b) An administrator, a liquidator, liquidation committee, or receiver or manager of property of the company; or
(c) If the company is a subsidiary, a director, employee, or auditor of
its holding company –
knowing it to be false or misleading.
(3) Every person who commits an offence against subsections (1) or (2) is
liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years or to a fine
not exceeding 1000 penalty units, or both.
(4) For the purposes of this Act, a person who voted in favour of the making
of a statement at a meeting is deemed to have authorised the making of the
statement.

338 Fraudulent use or destruction of company property

(1) Every director, employee, or shareholder of a company commits an
offence who –
(a) Fraudulently takes or applies property of the company for his or
her own use or benefit, or for a use or purpose other than the use or
purpose of the company; or
(b) Fraudulently conceals or destroys property of the company.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against subsection (1) is liable
on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years or to a fine not
exceeding 1000 penalty units, or both.

339 Falsification of records

(1) Every director, employee, or shareholder of a company commits an
offence who, with intent to defraud or deceive a person –
(a) Destroys, parts with, mutilates, alters, or falsifies, or is a party to
the destruction, mutilation, alteration, or falsification of any register,
accounting records, book, paper, or other document belonging or
relating to the company; or
(b) Makes, or is a party to the making of, a false entry in any register,
accounting records, book, paper, or other document belonging or
relating to the company.
(2) Every person commits an offence who, in relation to a mechanical,
electronic, or other device used in connection with the keeping or preparation of
any register, accounting or other records, index, book, paper, or other document
for the purposes of a company or this Act –
(a) Records or stores in the device, or makes available to a person from
the device, matter that he or she knows to be false or misleading in
a material particular; or
(b) With intent to falsify or render misleading any such register,
accounting or other records, index, book, paper, or other document,
destroys, removes, or falsifies any matter recorded or stored in the
device, or fails or omits to record or store any matter in the device.
(3) Every person who commits an offence against subsections (1) or (2) is
liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years or to a fine
not exceeding 1000 penalty units, or both.

Companies Act 2006

445

340 Carrying on business fraudulently

(1) Every person commits an offence who is knowingly a party to a
company carrying on business with intent to defraud creditors of the company or
any other person or for a fraudulent purpose.
(2) Every director of a company commits an offence who –
(a) By false pretences or other fraud induces a person to give credit to
the company; or
(b) With intent to defraud creditors of the company –
(i) gives, transfers, or causes a charge to be given on, property of
the company to any person; or
(ii) causes property to be given or transferred to any person; or
(iii) caused or was a party to execution being levied against property
of the company.
(3) Every person who commits an offence against subsections (1) or (2) is
liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years or to a fine
not exceeding 1000 penalty units, or both.

Subpart 2 – Privileged communications and service of documents

341 Privileged communications

(1) Nothing in this Act requires a legal practitioner to disclose a privileged
communication.
(2) For the purposes of this Act, a communication is a
privileged communication only if –
(a) It is a confidential communication, whether oral or written, passing
between –
(i) a legal practitioner in his or her professional capacity and
another legal practitioner in that capacity; or
(ii) a legal practitioner in his or her professional capacity and his
or her client –
whether made directly or indirectly through an agent; and
(b) It is made or brought into existence for the purpose of obtaining or
giving legal advice or assistance; and
(c) It is not made or brought into existence for the purpose of
committing or furthering the commission of an illegal or wrongful
act.
(3) If the information or document consists wholly of payments, income,
expenditure, or financial transactions of a specified person (whether a legal
practitioner, his or her client, or any other person), it is not a privileged
communication if it is contained in, or comprises the whole or part of, a book,
account, statement or other record prepared or kept by the legal practitioner in
connection with a trust account of the legal practitioner.
(4) The Court may, on the application of any person, determine whether
or not a claim of privilege is valid and may, for that purpose, require the information
or document to be produced.

342 Service of documents on companies in legal proceedings

A document, including a writ, summons, notice, or order, in any legal proceedings
may be served on a company as follows –
(a) By delivery to a person named as a director of the company on the
Niue register; or
(b) By delivery to an employee of the company at the company’s head
office or principal place of business; or
446 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) By leaving it at the company’s registered office; or
(d) By serving it in accordance with any directions as to service given
by the Court having jurisdiction in the proceedings; or
(e) In accordance with an agreement made with the company; or
(f) By serving it at an address for service given in accordance with the
rules of the Court having jurisdiction in the proceedings or by such
means as a solicitor has, in accordance with those rules, stated that
the solicitor will accept service.

343 Service of other documents on companies

A document, other than a document in any legal proceedings, may be served
on a company as follows –
(a) By any of the methods set out in section 342(a), (b), (c), or (e);
(b) By posting it to the company’s postal address;
(c) By faxing it to a fax number at the company’s registered office or its
head office or principal place of business.

344 Service of documents on overseas companies in legal proceedings

A document, including a writ, summons, notice, or order, in any legal
proceedings may be served on an overseas company in Niue as follows –
(a) By delivery to a person named in the overseas register as a director
of the overseas company and who is resident in Niue;
(b) By delivery to a person named in the overseas register as being
authorised to accept service in Niue of documents on behalf of the
overseas company;
(c) By delivery to an employee of the overseas company at the overseas
company’s place of business in Niue or, if the overseas company
has more than 1 place of business in Niue, at the overseas company’s
principal place of business in Niue;
(d) By serving it in accordance with any directions as to service given
by the Court having jurisdiction in the proceedings;
(e) In accordance with an agreement made with the overseas company.

345 Service of other documents on overseas companies

A document, other than a document in any legal proceedings, may be served
on an overseas company as follows –
(a) By any of the methods set out in section 344(a), (b), (c), or (e);
(b) By posting it to the postal address in Niue of the overseas company;
(c) By posting it to the postal address of a person named in the overseas
register as being authorised to accept service in Niue of documents
on behalf of the overseas company;
(d) By faxing it to a fax number at the principal place of business in
Niue of the overseas company.

346 Service of documents on shareholders and creditors

(1) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder or creditor who is a natural person may be –
(a) Delivered to that person; or
(b) Posted to that person’s postal address; or
(c) Faxed to a fax number used by that person.
(2) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder or creditor that is a company or an overseas company may be sent by
any of the methods of serving documents referred to in section 342 or section 344,
as the case may be.

Companies Act 2006

447
(3) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent or given to a creditor that is a body corporate, not being a company or an overseas company, may be –
(a) Delivered to a person who is a principal officer of the body corporate; or
(b) Delivered to an employee of the body corporate at the principal
office or principal place of business of the body corporate; or
(c) Delivered in such manner as the Court directs; or
(d) Delivered in accordance with an agreement made with the body
corporate; or
(e) Posted to the postal address of the body corporate; or
(f) Faxed to a fax number at the principal office or principal place of
business of the body corporate.

347 Additional provisions relating to service

(1) Subject to subsection (2), for the purposes of sections 342 to 346 –
(a) If a document is to be served by delivery to a natural person, service
must be made –
(i) by handing the document to the person; or
(ii) if the person refuses to accept the document, by bringing it to
the attention of, and leaving it in a place accessible to, the
person;
(b) A document that is posted is deemed to be received 5 working days
after it is posted;
(c) A document that is faxed is deemed to have been received on the
working day following the day on which it was faxed;
(d) In proving service of a document by post, it is sufficient to prove
that –
(i) the document was properly addressed; and
(ii) all postal or delivery charges were paid; and
(iii) the document was posted;
(e) In proving service of a faxed document, it is sufficient to prove that
the document was properly faxed to the person concerned.
(2) A document is not to be deemed to have been served or sent or delivered
to a person if the person proves that, through no fault on the person’s part, the
document was not received within the time specified.

348 Regulations

Subpart 3 – Regulation-making powers

(1) Cabinet may make regulations for all or any of the following purposes;

Fees

(a) Prescribing fees or other amounts payable to the Registrar in respect
of the performance of functions and the exercise of powers under
this Act;
(b) Prescribing amounts payable to the Registrar by way of penalty for
failure to deliver a document to the Registrar within the time
prescribed by this Act;
(c) Prescribing fees or other amounts payable to the Registrar in respect
of any other matter under this Act;
(d) Prescribing fees or other amounts payable to the Registrar of the
High Court in respect of any Court proceedings under this Act;
448 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Forms

(e) Prescribing forms (including Court forms) for the purposes of this
Act; and those regulations may require –
(i) The inclusion in, or attachment to, forms of specified
information or documents;
(ii) forms to be signed by specified persons;

Registration requirements

(f) Prescribing requirements, not inconsistent with this Act, with which
documents delivered for registration must comply;

Financial reporting requirements

(g) Regulating the financial reporting of a company, overseas company,
or class of companies or overseas companies, including (without
limitation) –
(i) prescribing requirements in respect of the adoption by directors
of a balance date for a company;
(ii) regulating changes to the balance date of a company;
(h) Prescribing requirements, not inconsistent with this Act, in relation
to the form or content of financial statements, or any other matters
in respect of financial statements, including (without limitation) –
(i) prescribing different requirements in respect of different classes
of company;
(ii) requiring compliance with standards issued or published by a
specified body or bodies, with or without modifications;

Liquidations

(i) regulating, in a manner not inconsistent with this Act, the conduct
of liquidations;
(j) Fixing an amount or prescribing a rate or rates in respect of the
remuneration of liquidators, and without limiting what may be
prescribed by such regulations, those regulations may –
(i) prescribe an hourly or other rate or rates of remuneration and
different rates may be prescribed in respect of work undertaken
in the liquidation by different classes of persons;
(ii) prescribe a rate or rates by reference to the net value of the
assets realised by the liquidator, together with any other
amounts that may be specified;
(iii) prescribe a rate or rates in respect of the exercise of a particular
function or power;
(iv) prescribe a rate or rates by reference to any other criteria that
may be specified;

Court proceedings under this Act

(k) Providing for and regulating any Court proceedings under this Act;

Exemption from requirements of Part 11

(l) Providing for any class or classes of overseas company to be
exempted from the application of any or all of the requirements of
Part 11, or modifying the application of Part 11 to such overseas
companies, on any terms and conditions;

Companies Act 2006

449

Transitional and savings provisions

(m) Prescribing transitional and savings provisions relating to the
coming into force of this Act;

Modifying Schedules

(n) Amending the model rules in Schedules 2, 3, and 4;
(o) Replacing all or any of the model rules in Schedules 2, 3, and 4;
(p) Specifying the class or classes of companies to which the amended
model rules or replaced model rules will apply;
(q) Specifying the date or occasion on which the amended model rules
or replaced model rules take effect or will apply;
(r) Without limiting paragraphs (p) and (q), specifying whether the
amended model rules or replaced model rules apply to all
companies to which the relevant model rules apply, or only to
companies incorporated after the date on which the amended model
rules or replaced model rules take effect;
(s) Amending the provisions of Schedules 7, 11, 12, 16, 18, and 19;

General

(t) Providing for any other matters contemplated by this Act, necessary
for its administration, or necessary for giving it full effect.
(2) The Registrar may refuse to perform a function or exercise a power
until the prescribed fee or amount is paid.
(3) Any regulations made under subsection (1) may authorise the Registrar
to waive, in whole or in part and on any conditions that may be prescribed,
payment of any amount referred to in paragraph (b) of that subsection.
(4) If the Registrar requires a company to change its name, no fee is payable
in respect of an application to change the name of the company.
(5) Any fee or amount payable to the Registrar is recoverable by the
Registrar in any Court of competent jurisdiction as a debt due to the Government.

Subpart 4–Repeals and transitional provisions

349 International business companies

(1) No company may be incorporated under the International Business
Companies Act 1994 after this section comes into force, despite section 3 of that
Act.
(2) The International Business Companies Act 1994 is repealed on, and with effect from, 31 December 2006.

350 Repeals and revocations

(1) The enactments specified in Schedule 20 are repealed on the expiry of
the transition period.
(2) The regulations specified in Schedule 21 are revoked on the expiry of
the transition period.
450

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

SCHEDULE 1
s 3
INTERPRETATION

1

Definitions

4

Meaning of related company

2

Meaning of subsidiary

5

Solvency test

3

Meaning of holding company

–––––––––––––––––

1 Definitions

In this Act, unless the context otherwise requires –
accounting period, in relation to a company, means a year ending on a
balance date of the company and, if as a result of the date of the
registration of the company or a change of the balance date of the
company, the period ending on that date is longer or shorter than a
year, that longer or shorter period is an accounting period
administrator means an administrator appointed under subpart 1 of Part 9
alteration document means a document that provides for the alteration of
a registered charge
arrangement includes a reorganisation of the share capital of a company
by the consolidation of shares of different classes, or by the division of
shares into shares of different classes, or by both those methods
assignee means the person to whom the benefit of a registered charge is
assigned
assignment document means a document that provides for the assignment
of a registered charge
balance date, in relation to a company, means the close of 31 March or of
any other date that the directors of the company adopt as the company’s
balance date in accordance with any regulations made under this Act
board and board of directors, in relation to a company, means –
(a) Directors of the company who number not less than the required
quorum acting together as a board of directors; or
(b) If the company has only 1 director, that director –
broadcasting means any transmission of programmes, whether or not
encrypted, by radio waves or other means of telecommunication for
reception by the public by means of broadcasting receiving apparatus;
but does not include any such transmission of programmes –
(a)Made on the demand of a particular person for reception only by
that person; or
(b) Made solely for performance or display in a public place
charge document –
(a) Means a document that creates, or provides for, a company charge;
and
(b) In the case of an issue by a company of a series of debentures,
includes a deed that contains, or refers to, a charge created by the
company that entitles the debenture holders of the series to rank
equally
committee of creditors, in relation to a company under administration,
means a committee of creditors of the company appointed under
subpart 1 of Part 9

Companies Act 2006

451
company means a company registered or reregistered under this Act compromise means a compromise between a company and its creditors,
including a compromise –
(a) Cancelling all or part of a debt of the company; or
(b) Varying the rights of its creditors or the terms of a debt; or
(c) Relating to an alteration of a company’s rules that affects the
likelihood of the company being able to pay a debt
convening period, in relation to an administration of a company –
(a) means a period of 20 working days commencing on the day when
the administration begins; and
(b) Includes any extension to that period granted by the Court
court officer means a constable or the Registrar or other officer of the Court
creditor –
(a) in subpart 2 of Part 8 (approval of amalgamations, etc, by Court), subpart 1 of Part 9 (administrations), and subpart 2 of Part 9 (compromises with creditors) includes –
(i) a person who, in a liquidation, would be entitled to claim that a debt is owing to that person by the company; and
(ii) a secured creditor;
(b) In subpart 3 of Part 9 (liquidations) –
(i) Means a person who, in a liquidation, would be entitled to claim
in accordance with clause 2 of Schedule 18 that a debt is owing
to that person by the company; and
(ii) includes a secured creditor only –
(A) For the purposes of sections 217, 221, and 254 and clause 5 of
Schedule 15; or
(B) To the extent of the amount of any debt owing to the secured creditor
in respect of which the secured creditor claims under Part 2 of
Schedule 18 as an unsecured creditor
decision period, in relation to a charge on property of a company under
administration, means the period –
(a) Beginning on the day when –
(i) if notice of the appointment of the administrator must be given
to the secured creditor, the notice is given; or
(ii) otherwise, the administration begins; and
(b) Ending at the end of 15 working days after that day
director, in relation to a company –
(a) includes a person occupying the position of director of the company
by whatever name called; but
(b) Does not include a receiver
directors has the same meaning as the definitions of board and board of
directors
distribution, in relation to a distribution by a company to a shareholder,
means –
(a) the direct or indirect transfer of money or property, other than the
company’s own shares, to or for the benefit of the shareholder; or
(b) The incurring of a debt to or for the benefit of the shareholder –
in relation to shares held by that shareholder, whether by means of a
dividend, a purchase, redemption or other acquisition of shares, a
distribution of indebtedness, or some other means
document –
452 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) means information in written or electronic form, or both; and
(b) Includes anything from which information may be reproduced
(with or without the aid of anything else)
electronic includes electrical, digital, magnetic, optical, electromagnetic,
biometric, and photonic
enforce, in relation to a charge on property of a company under
administration, includes –
(a) Appointing a receiver of property of the company under a power
contained in a charge document; and
(b) Obtaining an order for the appointment of a receiver of the property
for the purpose of enforcing the charge; and
(c) Entering into possession, or assuming control, of the property for
that purpose; and
(d) Appointing a person to enter into possession or to assume control
(whether as agent for the secured creditor or for the company); and
(e) Exercising, as secured creditor or as a receiver or person so
appointed, a right, power, or remedy existing because of the charge,
whether arising under the charge document, under a written or
unwritten law, or otherwise
enforcement process, in relation to property, means –
(a) Execution against that property; or
(b) Any other enforcement process in relation to that property that
involves a Court
essential service means –
(a) the retail supply of electricity;
(b) The retail supply of fuel and other similar consumable items
necessary for the generation of electricity;
(c) The retail supply of gas;
(d) The supply of water;
(e) Telecommunications services
existing charge means a charge that was created by an existing company
or overseas company, as the case may be, before the commencement of
this Act
financial statements, in relation to a company and a balance date, means –
(a) A statement of financial position for the company as at the balance
date; and
(b) In the case of –
(i) a company trading for profit, a statement of financial
performance for the company in relation to the accounting
period ending at the balance date; and
(ii) a company not trading for profit, an income and expenditure
statement for the company in relation to the accounting period
ending at the balance date; and
(c) If required by regulations made under this Act, a statement of cash
flows for the company in relation to the accounting period ending
on the balance date; and
(d) Any other financial statements in relation to the company or any
group of companies of which it is the holding company as may be
required by regulations made under this Act; and
(e) Any notes or documents giving information relating to the
statement of financial position and other statements
information includes information (whether in its original form or otherwise)

Companies Act 2006

453
that is in the form of a document, a signature, a seal, data, text, images, sound, or speech
international business company means a company registered under the
International Business Companies Act 1994
liquidator means a liquidator appointed under subpart 3 of Part 9
major transaction has the meaning set out in section 50(2)
model rules means the model rules of incorporation set out in Schedules 2,
3, or 4
Minister means the Minister responsible for the administration of this Act
Niue register means the register kept by the Registrar under section 323(1)(a)
onerous property means –
(a) An unprofitable contract; or
(b) Property of the company that is unsaleable, or not readily saleable,
or which may give rise to a liability to pay money or perform an
onerous act
overseas company means a corporation that is incorporated outside Niue,
whether or not it is registered under Part 11
overseas register means the register kept by the Registrar under section
323(1)(b)
preferential claim means a claim referred to in Part 3 of Schedule 18 (except
clause 15 of that schedule)
prescribed form means a form prescribed by regulations or, if no form is
prescribed by regulations, a form approved by the Registrar
priority document means a document that has the effect of postponing the
priority of a registered charge
private company means a company that is registered as a private company
on the Niue register
property includes –
(a) Real and personal property; and
(b) An estate or interest in real or personal property; and
(c) A debt; and
(d) Any thing in action; and
(e) Any other rights, interests, and claims of any kind in relation to
property
proponent means a person who proposed a compromise in accordance with
subpart 2 of Part 9
public company means a company that is registered as a public company
on the Niue register
receiver means a receiver, or a manager, or a receiver and manager in respect
of any property appointed –
(a) By or under any deed or agreement; or
(b) By the Court in the exercise of a power conferred on the Court or in
the exercise of its inherent jurisdiction –
whether or not the person appointed is empowered to sell any of the property in
receivership; but does not include –
(c) A mortgagee who, whether personally or through an agent,
exercises a power –
(i) to receive income from mortgaged property; or
(ii) to enter into possession or assume control of mortgaged
property; or
(iii) to sell or otherwise alienate mortgaged property; or
454

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

(d) An agent of any such mortgagee
registered charge means a charge registered in accordance with Schedule 7
registered document means a document –
(a) that forms part of any of the registers referred to in section 323(1);
(b) Details of which have been entered in any device or facility referred
to in section 323(3)
registered office, in relation to a company, has the meaning set out in section
17
registrable charge has the meaning set out in clause 1 of Schedule 7
Registrar means the Registrar of Companies appointed under section 305
rules means the rules of a company
Secretary means the Financial Secretary
shareholder means a person whose name is entered on the share register of
a company as the holder of 1 or more shares in the company
solvency test means the solvency test referred to in clause 5
special resolution means a resolution –
(a) Approved in accordance with section 52; or
(b) Approved at a meeting of shareholders called to consider that
resolution on not less than 10 working days’ notice –
(i) by a majority of 75% (or such higher majority as may be
specified in the rules) of the votes of shareholders entitled to
vote and voting on the question; and
(ii) in accordance with any additional requirements specified in
the rules in respect of such resolutions
telecommunications services –
(a) means the conveyance by electromagnetic means from 1 device to
another of any encrypted or non-encrypted sign, signal, impulse,
writing, image, sound, instruction, information, or intelligence of
any nature, whether for the information of any person using the
device or not; but
(b) Does not include any conveyance that constitutes broadcasting.

2 Meaning of subsidiary

(1) For the purposes of this Act, a company is a subsidiary of another
company if, but only if –
(a) That other company –
(i) controls the composition of the board of the company; or
(ii) is in a position to exercise, or control the exercise of, more than
one-half the maximum number of votes that may be exercised
at a meeting of the company; or
(iii) holds more than one-half of the issued shares of the company,
other than shares that carry no right to participate beyond a
specified amount in a distribution of either profits or capital;
or
(iv) is entitled to receive more than one-half of every dividend paid
on shares issued by the company, other than shares that carry
no right to participate beyond a specified amount in a
distribution of either profits or capital; or
(b) The company is a subsidiary of a company that is that other
company’s subsidiary.
(2) In subsection (1), company includes a corporation.

Companies Act 2006

455

3 Meaning of holding company

(1) For the purposes of this Act, a company is another company’s holding
company if that other company is its subsidiary.
(2) In subsection (1), company includes a corporation.

4 Meaning of related company

(1) For the purposes of this Act, a company is related to another company
if –
(a) The other company is its holding company or subsidiary; or
(b) More than half of the issued shares of the company, other than shares
that carry no right to participate beyond a specified amount in a
distribution of either profits or capital, is held by the other company
and companies related to that other company (whether directly or
indirectly, but other than in a fiduciary capacity); or
(c) More than half of the issued shares, other than shares that carry no
right to participate beyond a specified amount in a distribution of
either profits or capital, of each of them is held by members of the
other (whether directly or indirectly, but other than in a fiduciary
capacity); or
(d) The businesses of the companies have been so carried on that the
separate business of each company, or a substantial part of it, is not
readily identifiable; or
(e) There is another company to which both companies are related; –
and related company has a corresponding meaning.
(2) In subsection (1), company includes a corporation.

5 Solvency test

(1) For the purposes of this Act, a company satisfies the solvency test if –
(a) The company is able to pay its debts as they become due in the
normal course of business; and
(b) The value of the company’s assets is not less than the value of its
liabilities.
(2) A person required to consider whether a company satisfies the solvency
test in subsection (1) may have regard to –
(a) Financial statements prepared on the basis of accounting practices
and principles that are reasonable in the circumstances; and
(b) Valuations of assets or liabilities; and
(c) Such other information in relation to the financial position of the
company as is reasonable in all the circumstances.
(3) If the rules of a company provide for a solvency margin that must be
maintained by the company, subsection (1)(b) applies in relation to that company
as if that solvency margin were a liability of the company, except where the surplus
assets of the company are being distributed –
(a) In a liquidation; or
(b) Before the removal of the company from the Niue register in
accordance with Part 10.
––––––––––––––––––––
456 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
SCHEDULE 2
MODEL RULES FOR PRIVATE COMPANY
s 15(1)

PART 1

GENERAL PROVISIONS

1

Name of company

2

Private company

3

Rules

PART 2

SHARES AND SHAREHOLDERS

General provisions

4

Number of shares

5

Rights attaching to shares

6

Issue of shares

7

Process for issuing shares

8

Transferability of shares

Share register

9

Company to keep share register

10

Form and location of share register

11

Status of registered shareholder

Pre-emptive rights

12

Restriction on selling shares

13

Selling shareholder to give written notice

to company

14

Company to give written notice to

shareholders

15

Written notice is offer by selling

shareholder

16

Notice agreeing to purchase shares given

within specified time

17

Notice agreeing to purchase shares not

given within specified time

18

No shareholder wishes to purchase selling

shareholder ’s shares

19

Selling shareholder not obliged to sell some

shares

20

Directors may require evidence of terms

Transfer of shares

21

Transfer of shares

22

Share certificates

Meetings of shareholders

23

Meetings of shareholders

24

Notice of meetings

25

Methods of holding meetings

26

Quorum

27

Chairperson

28

Voting

29

Votes of joint shareholders

30

Proxies

Companies Act 2006

457

64

PART 4

COMPANY RECORDS

Company records

72

Auditor ’s attendance at shareholders’

meeting

65

Form of records

PART 6

66

Access to records

LIQUIDATION AND REMOVAL FROM REGISTER

67

Documents to be sent to Registrar

73

Resolution to appoint liquidator

68

Documents to be sent to shareholders

74

Distribution of surplus assets

PART 5

PART 7

ACCOUNTS AND AUDIT

MISCELLANEOUS

69

Accounting records to be kept

75

Service of documents on shareholders

70

Financial statements to be prepared

76

Interpretation

71

Appointment of auditor

1 Name of company

––––––––––––––––––––

PART 1
GENERAL PROVISIONS
(1) The name of the company at the time of registration under the Act appears on the application for registration or for reregistration, as the case may be.
(2) The name of the company may be changed in accordance with section
11 of the Act only with the prior approval of all shareholders.

2 Private company

(1) The company is a private company.
(2) The company must not offer any of its shares or other securities to the
public.
(3) The company must not have more than 100 shareholders.
(4) If a share transfer is presented to the company for entry on the share
register that would result in a breach of this restriction, the directors must decline to register the transfer.

3 Rules

(1) The company may adopt new rules in place of these rules by special
resolution, in accordance with section 14(2) of the Act.
(2) Subject to the Act –
(a) These rules have effect and may be enforced as if they constituted a
contract –
(i) between the company and its shareholders; and
(ii) between the company and each director; and
(b) The shareholders and directors of the company have the rights,
powers, duties, and obligations set out in these rules.

4 Number of shares

PART 2
SHARES AND SHAREHOLDERS

General provisions

(1) At the time of registration under the Act, the company has the number of shares specified in the application for registration or reregistration, as the case may be.
(2) If the company was first registered under Part 2 of the Act, the company
must immediately after its registration issue to any person named in the application
458 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
for registration as a shareholder the number of shares specified in the application as being the number of shares to be issued to that person or those persons.

5 Rights attaching to shares

Subject to clause 7(2), each share carries the following rights –
(a) The right to 1 vote on a poll at a meeting of the company on any
resolution, including any resolution to –
(i) appoint or remove a director or auditor;
(ii) adopt new rules;
(iii) alter the company’s rules;
(iv) approve a major transaction;
(v) approve an amalgamation of the company;
(vi) approve reregistration of the company as a public company;
(vii) put the company into liquidation;
(viii) approve the transfer of registration of the company to another
country;
(b) The right to an equal share in dividends paid by the company;
(c) The right to an equal share in the distribution of the surplus assets
of the company in a liquidation.

6 Issue of shares

The directors may issue shares –
(a) In accordance with clause 7; or
(b) To shareholders or any other persons on any other basis, with the
prior approval of all shareholders.

7 Process for issuing shares

(1) The directors may issue shares in accordance with the following
process –
(a) The shares must first be offered to all shareholders proportionally, on such terms as the directors think fit, pursuant to an offer that, if accepted by all shareholders, would not affect relative voting or distribution rights. The shareholders must have a reasonable opportunity to consider and respond to the offer;
(b) Any shares not accepted by the shareholders to whom they were
offered under paragraph (a) must then be offered to those
shareholders who did accept the shares offered to them under
paragraph (a), on a fair and equitable basis determined by the
directors and on the same terms and conditions as the offer made
under paragraph (a);
(c) Any shares offered under paragraph (b), but not taken up by
shareholders may then be offered by the directors to shareholders
or any other persons in such manner as the directors think fit, on
the same terms and conditions as the offer made under paragraph
(a).
(2) With the prior approval of all shareholders, the company may issue
more than 1 class of shares. In particular, shares may be issued that –
(a) Are redeemable; or
(b) Confer preferential rights to distributions of capital or income; or
(c) Confer special, limited, or conditional voting rights; or
(d) Do not confer voting rights.

Companies Act 2006

459
(3) If the company issues shares, it must give the prescribed notice to the Registrar under section 26(2) of the Act within 10 working days of the issue of any shares.
(4) If the rights attached to the shares differ from those set out in clause 5, the notice must be accompanied by a document setting out the terms of issue of the shares.

8 Transferability of shares

The shares of the company are, subject to clauses 12(1) and 21(4) and their
terms of issue, transferable by entry in the share register in accordance with
subclauses 21(1) to (3).

Share register

9 Company to keep share register

(1) The company must maintain a share register that records the shares
issued by the company and states –
(a) The names, alphabetically arranged, and the last known address of
each person who is, or has within the last 7 years been, a shareholder;
and
(b) The number of shares of each class held by each shareholder within
the last 7 years; and
(c) The date of any –
(i) issue of shares to; or
(ii) repurchase or redemption of shares from; or
(iii) transfer of shares by or to –
each shareholder within the last 7 years, and in relation to the transfer, the
name of the person to or from whom the shares were transferred.
(2) No notice of a trust, whether express, implied, or constructive, may be
entered on the share register.
(3) The company may appoint an agent to maintain the share register.

10 Form and location of share register

The share register must be kept –
(a) In a form that complies with clause 65; and
(b) At the company’s registered office, or at any other place in Niue
notice of which has been given to the Registrar under section 119 of
the Act.

11 Status of registered shareholder

(1) The company must treat the registered holder of a share as the only
person entitled to –
(a) Exercise the right to vote attaching to the share; and
(b) Receive notices; and
(c) Receive a distribution in respect of the share; and
(d) Exercise the other rights and powers attaching to the share.
(2) If a joint holder of a share dies, the remaining holders must be treated
by the company as the holders of that share.
(3) If the sole holder of a share dies, that shareholder ’s legal representative
is the only person recognised by the company as having any title to, or interest in,
the share.
(4) Any person who becomes entitled to a share as a consequence of the
death, bankruptcy or insolvency, or incapacity of a shareholder may be registered
460 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
as the holder of that shareholder ’s shares on making a request in writing to the company to be so registered, accompanied by proof satisfactory to the directors of that entitlement.

Pre-emptive rights

12 Restriction on selling shares

(1) A shareholder is not entitled to sell or otherwise dispose of his or her
shares in the company without first offering to sell them to the other holders of
shares of the same class in accordance with the procedure set out in clauses 13 to
20, unless all the other shareholders agree otherwise.
(2) Any share transfer delivered to the company by a shareholder who has
not complied with subclause (1) is of no effect, and the transfer must not be entered
on the share register.

13 Selling shareholder to give written notice to company

A shareholder who wishes to dispose of some or all of his or her shares
(selling shareholder) must give written notice to the company of –
(a) The number of shares to be sold; and
(b) The price at which the selling shareholder is willing to sell the shares.

14 Company to give written notice to shareholders

The company must, within 10 working days, give a copy of the written
notice referred to in clause 13 to each shareholder, together with a notice advising
each holder of shares of the same class –
(a) That that shareholder is entitled to purchase a proportional number
of the shares that the selling shareholder wishes to sell (rounded in
an appropriate manner determined by the directors); and
(b) That, if that shareholder wishes to purchase those shares, he or she
must give written notice to that effect to the company within 10
working days of the date of the notice.

15 Written notice is offer by selling shareholder

The notice referred to in clause 14 is deemed to be an offer by the selling
shareholder to the recipient to sell the number of shares referred to in the notice at
the price specified by the selling shareholder in the notice given under clause 13,
on the terms set out in these rules.

16 Notice agreeing to purchase shares given within specified time

Subject to clause 19, if a notice is given by a shareholder within the specified
time agreeing to purchase the shares offered to that shareholder in a notice given
under clause 14 –
(a) There is deemed to be a contract between that shareholder and the
selling shareholder for the sale and purchase of the relevant number
of shares; and
(b) The company must immediately advise the selling shareholder of
the acceptance, and send him or her a copy of –
(i) the notice given under clause 14 by the company; and
(ii) the notice of acceptance given by the shareholder in question.

Companies Act 2006

461

17 Notice agreeing to purchase shares not given within specified time

(1) If any shareholder does not give notice agreeing to purchase the shares
offered to that shareholder within the specified time, the shares that were offered
to that shareholder must be offered to those shareholders who did accept the shares
offered to them, on a fair and equitable basis determined by the directors.
(2) Clauses 15 and 16 apply to any notice given to a shareholder, and to
any notice of acceptance given by a shareholder, under this clause.

18 No shareholder wishes to purchase selling shareholder’s shares

If no shareholder wishes to purchase the selling shareholder ’s shares at the
specified price, the selling shareholder may, at any time in the 12 months following
the giving of notice by the selling shareholder, sell some or all of those shares to
any other person at a price not less than the specified price.

19 Selling shareholder not obliged to sell some shares

(1) The selling shareholder is not obliged to sell all of the shares that he or
she wishes to dispose of.
(2) In the event that the selling shareholder has not been notified under
clause 16 of acceptances by other shareholders in respect of all the shares referred
to in the notice given under clause 13 within 40 working days of the date on which
that notice was given to the company, the selling shareholder may, at his or her
option, give written notice to the company terminating the offer to sell the shares
to the other shareholders.
(3) If such a notice is given, clause 18 applies as if no shareholder had
wished to purchase the selling shareholder ’s shares.

20 Directors may require evidence of terms

The directors may require reasonable evidence of the terms (including price)
on which the shares were sold to accompany any share transfer in respect of those
shares.

21 Transfer of shares

Transfer of shares

(1) If shares are to be transferred, a form of transfer signed by the holder or by his or her agent or attorney must be delivered to the company.
(2) The personal representative of a deceased shareholder may transfer a share even though the personal representative is not a shareholder at the time of transfer.
(3) Subject to clause 12 and subclause (4), the company must immediately on receipt of a properly executed share transfer enter the name of the transferee in the share register as holder of the shares transferred.
(4) If any amount payable to the company by the shareholder is due but unpaid, the directors may resolve to refuse to register a transfer of a share within
30 working days of receipt of the transfer.
(5) If the directors resolve to refuse to register a transfer for this reason,
they must give notice of the refusal to the shareholder within 5 working days of
the date of the resolution.

22 Share certificates

(1) A shareholder may apply to the company for a share certificate relating
to some or all of the shareholder ’s shares in the company.
462 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) On receipt of an application for a share certificate under subclause (1), the company must, within 20 working days after receiving the application –
(a) If the application relates to some but not all of the shares, separate the shares shown in the register as owned by the applicant into separate parcels; 1 parcel being the shares to which the share certificate relates, and the other parcel being any remaining shares; and
(b) In all cases send to the shareholder a certificate stating – (i) the name of the company; and
(ii) the class of shares held by the shareholder; and
(iii) the number of shares held by the shareholder to which the
certificate relates.
(3) If a share certificate has been issued, a transfer of the shares to which it
relates must not be registered by the company unless the form of transfer required
by that section is accompanied by –
(a) The share certificate relating to the share; or
(b) Evidence as to its loss or destruction and, if required, an indemnity
in a form determined by the directors.
(4) If shares to which a share certificate relates are to be transferred, and
the share certificate is sent to the company to enable the registration of the transfer,
the share certificate must be cancelled and no further share certificate issued except
at the request of the transferee.

Meetings of shareholders

23 Meetings of shareholders

(1) Clauses 24 to 32 set out the procedure to be followed at, and in relation
to, meetings of shareholders.
(2) A meeting of shareholders may determine its own procedure to the
extent that it is not governed by these rules.

24 Notice of meetings

(1) Written notice of the time and place of a meeting of shareholders must
be given to every shareholder entitled to receive notice of the meeting and to
every director and any auditor of the company not less than 10 working days
before the meeting.
(2) The notice must set out –
(a) The nature of the business to be transacted at the meeting in enough
detail to enable a shareholder to form a reasoned judgment in
relation to it; and
(b) The text of any special resolution to be submitted to the meeting.
(3) An irregularity in a notice of a meeting is waived if all the shareholders
entitled to attend and vote at the meeting attend the meeting without protest as to
the irregularity, or if all such shareholders agree to the waiver.
(4) An accidental omission to give notice of a meeting to, or the failure to
receive notice of a meeting by, a shareholder does not invalidate the proceedings
at that meeting.
(5) If a meeting of shareholders is adjourned for less than 30 working days,
it is not necessary to give notice of the time and place of the adjourned meeting
other than by announcement at the meeting that is adjourned.

Companies Act 2006

463

25 Methods of holding meetings

A meeting of shareholders may be held either –
(a) By a number of shareholders, who constitute a quorum, being
assembled together at the place, date, and time appointed for the
meeting; or
(b) By means of audio, or audio and visual, communication by which
all shareholders participating and constituting a quorum, may
simultaneously hear each other throughout the meeting.

26 Quorum

(1) Subject to subclause (3), no business may be transacted at a meeting of
shareholders if a quorum is not present.
(2) A quorum for a meeting of shareholders is present if shareholders or
their proxies are present who are between them able to exercise a majority of the
votes to be cast on the business to be transacted by the meeting.
(3) If a quorum is not present within 30 minutes after the time appointed
for the meeting, the meeting is adjourned to the same day in the following week
at the same time and place, or to such other date, time and place as the directors
may appoint.
(4) If, at the adjourned meeting, a quorum is not present within 30 minutes
after the time appointed for the meeting, the shareholders present or their proxies
are a quorum.

27 Chairperson

(1) If the directors have elected a chairperson of the directors, and the
chairperson of the directors is present at a meeting of shareholders, he or she
must chair the meeting.
(2) If no chairperson of the directors has been elected or if, at any meeting
of shareholders, the chairperson of the directors is not present within 15 minutes
of the time appointed for the commencement of the meeting, the shareholders
present may choose 1 of their number to be the chairperson of the meeting.

28 Voting

(1) In the case of a meeting of shareholders held under clause 25(a), unless
a poll is demanded, voting at the meeting must take place by whichever of the
following methods is determined by the chairperson of the meeting –
(a) Voting by voice; or
(b) Voting by show of hands.
(2) In the case of a meeting of shareholders held under clause 25(b), unless
a poll is demanded, voting at the meeting must take place by shareholders
signifying individually their assent or dissent by voice.
(3) A declaration by the chairperson of the meeting that a resolution is
carried by the requisite majority is conclusive evidence of that fact unless a poll is
demanded in accordance with subclause (4).
(4) At a meeting of shareholders a poll may be demanded by –
(a) Not fewer than 5 shareholders having the right to vote on the
question at the meeting; or
(b) A shareholder or shareholders representing not less than 10% of
the total voting rights of all shareholders having the right to vote
on the question at the meeting.
(5) A poll may be demanded either before or after a vote is taken on a
resolution.
464 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(6) If a poll is taken, votes must be counted according to the votes attached to the shares of each shareholder present and voting.
(7) The chairperson of a shareholders’ meeting is not entitled to a casting
vote.

29 Votes of joint shareholders

If 2 or more persons are registered as the holder of a share, the vote of the
person named first in the share register and voting on a matter must be accepted
to the exclusion of the votes of the other joint holders.

30 Proxies

(1) A shareholder may exercise the right to vote either by being present in
person or by proxy.
(2) A proxy for a shareholder is entitled to attend and participate in a
meeting of shareholders as if the proxy were the shareholder.
(3) A proxy must be appointed by notice in writing signed by the
shareholder.
(4) The notice must state whether the appointment is for a particular
meeting, or for a specified term.
(5) No proxy is effective in relation to a meeting unless a copy of the notice
of appointment is given to the company at least 24 hours before the start of the
meeting.

31 Corporations may act by representatives

(1) A corporation that is a shareholder may appoint a representative to
attend a meeting of shareholders on its behalf by notice in writing signed by a
director or secretary of the corporation.
(2) The notice must state whether the appointment is for a particular
meeting, or for a specified term.

32 Minutes

(1) The directors must ensure that minutes are kept of all proceedings at
meetings of shareholders.
(2) Minutes that have been signed correct by the chairperson of the meeting
are prima facie evidence of the proceedings at the meeting.

Miscellaneous

33 Annual meetings and special meetings of shareholders

(1) Subject to subclause (3) and clause 34(3), the directors must call an
annual meeting of the company to be held –
(a) Once in each calendar year; and
(b) Not later than 5 months after the balance date of the company (or,
if the time for completing the financial statements of the company
has been extended under clause 70(1)(a), not later than 20 working
days after the financial statements are required to be completed);
and
(c) Not later than 15 months after the previous annual meeting.
(2) The meeting must be held on the date on which it is called to be held.
(3) The company need not hold its first annual meeting in the calendar
year of its incorporation, but must hold that meeting within 18 months of its
incorporation.

Companies Act 2006

465
(4) A special meeting of shareholders entitled to vote on an issue – (a) May be called at any time by a director; and
(b) Must be called by the directors on the written request of shareholders holding shares carrying together not less than 5% of the votes that may be cast on that issue.

34 Written resolutions of shareholders

(1) A resolution in writing signed by shareholders, who together hold not
less than 75% of the votes entitled to be cast on that resolution at a meeting of
shareholders, is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of those shareholders.
(2) Any such resolution may consist of several documents (including fax
or other similar means of communication) in like form each signed or assented to
by 1 or more shareholders.
(3) The company need not hold an annual meeting if everything required
to be done at that meeting (by resolution or otherwise) is done by resolution in
accordance with subclause (1).
(4) Within 5 working days of a resolution being passed under subclause
(1), the company must send a copy of the resolution to every shareholder who did
not sign it.
(5) A resolution may be signed under subclause (1) without any prior notice
being given to shareholders.

35 Voting in interest groups

If the company proposes to take action that affects the rights attached to
shares within the meaning of section 54 of the Act, the action may not be taken
unless it is approved by a special resolution of each interest group, as defined in
section 54(3) of the Act.

36 Shareholders entitled to receive distributions

(1) The shareholders who are entitled to receive distributions are –
(a) If the directors fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders whose
names are registered in the share register on that date;
(b) If the directors do not fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders
whose names are registered in the share register on the day on which
the distribution is approved.
(2) A date fixed under subclause (1) must not precede by more than 20
working days the date on which the proposed action will be taken.

37 Shareholders entitled to exercise pre-emptive rights

The shareholders who are entitled to pre-emptive rights to acquire shares
in accordance with clause 12 are those shareholders whose names are registered
in the share register on the day on which notice is given to the company by the
selling shareholder under clause 13.

38 Shareholders entitled to attend and vote at meetings

(1) The shareholders who are entitled to receive notice of a meeting of
shareholders are –
(a) If the directors fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders whose
names are registered in the share register on that date;
(b) If the directors do not fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders
whose names are registered in the share register at the close of
business on the day immediately preceding the day on which the
notice is given.
466 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) A date fixed under subclause (1)(a) must not precede by more than 30 working days the date on which the meeting is to be held.
(3) Before a meeting of shareholders, the company may prepare a list of shareholders entitled to receive notice of the meeting, arranged in alphabetical order, and showing the number of shares held by each shareholder –
(a) If a date has been fixed under subclause (1)(a), as at that date; or
(b) If no such date has been fixed, as at the close of business on the day
immediately preceding the day on which the notice is given.
(4) A person named in a list prepared under subclause (3) is entitled to
attend the meeting and vote in respect of the shares shown opposite his or her
name in person or by proxy, except to the extent that –
(a) That person has, since the date on which the shareholders entitled
to receive notice of the meeting were determined, transferred any
of his or her shares to some other person; and
(b) The transferee of those shares has been registered as the holder of
those shares, and has requested before the commencement of the
meeting that his or her name be entered on the list prepared under
subclause (3).
(5) A shareholder may, on 2 working days’ notice, examine any list prepared
under subclause (3) during normal business hours at the registered office of the
company.

39 Distributions to shareholders

(1) The company must not pay a dividend or make any other distribution
to shareholders unless there are reasonable grounds for believing that, after that
distribution is made –
(a) The company will be able to pay its debts as they become due in
the normal course of business; and
(b) The value of the company’s assets will not be less than the value of
its liabilities.
(2) Subject to subclause (1) and to the terms of issue of any shares, the
company may pay a dividend to shareholders –
(a) Of the same amount in respect of each share of the same class, if the
payment of the dividend is authorised by the directors; or
(b) On any other basis, with the prior approval of all shareholders.
(3) A distribution made in breach of subclauses (1) or (2) may be recovered
by the company from the recipients or from the persons approving the distribution,
in accordance with section 29 of the Act.

40 Company may acquire its own shares and provide financial assistance

(1) The company may agree to acquire its own shares from a shareholder –
(a) With the prior approval of all shareholders; and
(b) Subject to the solvency test in clause 39(1).
(2) If the company acquires its own shares, those shares are deemed to be
cancelled immediately on acquisition.
(3) The company may give financial assistance to a person for the purpose
of, or in connection with, the purchase of a share issued or to be issued by the
company, whether directly or indirectly, only if –
(a) After providing the assistance, the company will satisfy the solvency
test in clause 39(1); and
(b) All shareholders have approved the giving of the assistance.

Companies Act 2006

467

41 Annual report to shareholders

(1) Subject to subclause (2), the directors of the company must, within 20
working days after the date on which the company is required to complete its
financial statements under section 130 of the Act –
(a) Prepare an annual report on the affairs of the company during the
accounting period ending on that date; and
(b) Send a copy of that report to each shareholder.
(2) The directors are only required to prepare an annual report in respect
of an accounting period if a shareholder has given written notice to the company
before the end of that accounting period requiring such a report to be prepared.
(3) If the directors are not required to prepare an annual report in respect
of an accounting period, they must send a notice to each shareholder to that effect
within the period referred to in subclause (1).
(4) Every annual report for the company must –
(a) Be in writing and be dated; and
(b) Include financial statements for the accounting period that comply
with section 130 of the Act; and
(c) If an auditor ’s report is required in relation to the financial
statements included in the report, include that auditor ’s report; and
(d) State the names of the persons holding office as directors of the
company as at the end of the accounting period and the names of
any persons who ceased to hold office as directors of the company
during the accounting period; and
(e) Contain any other information that may be required by regulations
made under the Act; and
(f) Be signed on behalf of the directors by 2 directors of the company
or, if the company has only 1 director, by that director.

42 Deemed approval by all shareholders for certain purposes

For the purposes of clauses 6, 7(2), and 40(1) and (3), a decision is deemed
to have been approved by all shareholders if –
(a) Notice of the proposed decision has been given to all shareholders
in accordance with clause 75; and
(b) No shareholder has responded within 10 working days objecting
to that decision; and
(c) Shareholders entitled to cast not less than 75% of the votes in relation
to a resolution to alter these rules have responded within 10 working
days approving that decision.
PART 3
DIRECTORS

43 Appointment and removal of directors

(1) The shareholders may by ordinary resolution fix the number of directors
of the company.
(2) A director may be appointed or removed by ordinary resolution passed
at a meeting called for the purpose, or by a written resolution in accordance with
clause 34(1).
(3) A director vacates office if he or she –
(a) Is removed from office in accordance with subclause (2); or
(b) Resigns in accordance with clause 44; or
(c) Becomes disqualified from being a director under section 85 of the
Act; or
(d) Dies.
468 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

44 Resignation of director

(1) A director may resign by delivering a signed written notice of
resignation to the registered office of the company.
(2) Subject to subclauses (3) and (4), a notice of resignation is effective when
it is received at the registered office, or at any later time specified in the notice.
(3) If the company has only 1 director, that director may not resign –
(a) Until that director has called a meeting of shareholders to receive
notice of the resignation; or
(b) If the company has only 1 shareholder, until that director has given
not less than 10 working days’ notice of the resignation to that
shareholder.
(4) A notice of resignation given by the sole director of the company does
not take effect, despite its terms, until the earlier of the appointment of another
director of the company or –
(a) The time and date for which the meeting of shareholders is called
under subclause (3)(a); or
(b) If the company has only 1 shareholder, 10 working days after notice
of the resignation has been given to that shareholder.

45 Notice of change in directors

(1) The company must ensure that notice in the prescribed form of the
following is delivered to the Registrar –
(a) A change in the directors of the company, whether as the result of a
director ceasing to hold office or the appointment of a new director,
or both;
(b) A change in the name or the residential address of a director of the
company.
(2) In the case of the appointment of a new director, a consent by that person
to act as a director, in the prescribed form, must also be delivered to the Registrar.

46 Powers and duties of directors

(1) Subject to section 50 of the Act (which relates to major transactions),
the business and affairs of the company must be managed by, or under the direction
or supervision of, the directors.
(2) The directors have all the powers necessary for managing, and for
directing and supervising the management of, the business and affairs of the
company.
(3) The directors may delegate any of their powers to a committee of
directors, or to a director or employee.
(4) The directors must monitor, by means of reasonable methods properly
used, the exercise of powers by any delegate.
(5) The provisions of these rules relating to proceedings of the directors
also apply to proceedings of any committee of directors, except to the extent the
directors determine otherwise.
(6) The directors have the duties set out in the Act, and, in particular –
(a) Each director must act in good faith and in a manner that the director
believes to be in the interests of the company; and
(b) A director must not act, or agree to the company acting, in a manner
that contravenes the Act or these rules.

Companies Act 2006

469

47 Standard of care of directors

A director of the company, when exercising powers or performing duties
as a director, must exercise the care, diligence, and skill that a reasonable person would exercise in the same circumstances taking into account, but without limitation –
(a) The nature of the company; and
(b) The nature of the decision; and
(c) The position of the director and the nature of the responsibilities
undertaken by him or her.

48 Obligations of directors in connection with insolvency

(1) A director of the company must call a meeting of directors within 10
working days to consider whether the directors should appoint an administrator
or liquidator, in accordance with section 71 of the Act, if the director –
(a) Believes that the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall
due; or
(b) Is aware of matters that would put any reasonable person on inquiry
as to whether the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall
due.
(2) At a meeting called under section 71 of the Act, the directors must
consider whether to –
(a) Appoint an administrator or liquidator; or
(b) Continue to carry on the business of the company.

49 Interested directors

(1) A director must not exercise any power as a director in circumstances
where that director is directly or indirectly materially interested in the exercise of
that power ,unless –
(a) The Act expressly authorises the director to exercise the relevant
power despite such an interest; or
(b) The director has reasonable grounds for believing that the company
will satisfy the solvency test after that power is exercised, and
either –
(i) these rules expressly authorise the director to exercise the
relevant power despite such an interest; or
(ii) the matter in question has been approved by shareholders
under section 51 of the Act, following disclosure of the nature
and extent of the director ’s interest to all shareholders who are
not otherwise aware of those matters.
(2) A director who is directly or indirectly materially interested in any
transaction or proposed transaction must, within 10 working days of becoming
aware of that interest, disclose the nature and extent of that interest in writing –
(a) If there is at least 1 other director who is not directly or indirectly
materially interested in the transaction or proposed transaction, to
the directors of the company; or
(b) If paragraph (a) does not apply, to all shareholders other than the
director.
(3) A director may give a general disclosure in writing to all other
shareholders that the director is a director or employee or shareholder of another
company, or is otherwise associated with another company or another person.
That general disclosure is a sufficient disclosure of the director ’s interest in any
transaction entered into with that other company or person for the purposes of
subclause (2).
470 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(4) A transaction entered into by the company in which a director is directly or indirectly materially interested is voidable at the election of the company in accordance with section 111 of the Act.
(5) A transaction entered into by the company as the result of action taken by a director in breach of sections 65, 66, or 67 of the Act is voidable at the option of the company in accordance with section 112 of the Act.

50 Use and disclosure of company information

(1) A director of the company who has information in his or her capacity
as a director or employee of the company, being information that would not
otherwise be available to him or her, must not disclose that information to any
person, or make use of or act on the information, except –
(a) In the interests of the company; or
(b) As required by law; or
(c) If there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company will
satisfy the solvency test after the director takes that action, and that
action –
(i) is approved by all shareholders under section 51 of the Act; or
(ii) is authorised by any contract of employment entered into
between that director and the company, the relevant terms of
which have been approved by shareholders by ordinary
resolution.
(2) No director may vote on a resolution to approve such terms in relation
to himself or herself.

51 Indemnities and insurance for directors or employees

(1) Subject to section 74 of the Act, the company may provide an indemnity
or purchase insurance for a director of the company or of a related company with
the approval of –
(a) Shareholders by ordinary resolution.; or
(b) All shareholders under section 51 of the Act.
(2) No director may vote on a resolution concerning an indemnity or
insurance to be provided for the director.
(3) In this clause –
director includes –
(a) A person who is liable under any of sections 65 to 67 of the Act by
virtue of section 73 of the Act; and
(b) A former director
indemnify includes relieve or excuse from liability, whether before or after
the liability arises; and indemnity has a corresponding meaning.

52 Remuneration of directors

(1) Directors may receive remuneration and other benefits from the
company with the approval of –
(a) Shareholders by ordinary resolution; or
(b) All shareholders under section 51 of the Act.
(2) No director may vote on a resolution concerning remuneration or
benefits to be received by the director.

53 Procedure at meetings of directors

(1) Clauses 54 to 60 set out the procedure to be followed at meetings of
directors.

Companies Act 2006

471
(2) A meeting of directors may determine its own procedure to the extent that it is not governed by these rules.

54 Chairperson

(1) The directors may elect 1 of their number as chairperson of directors
and may determine the period for which the chairperson is to hold office.
(2) If no chairperson is elected, or if at a meeting of the directors the
chairperson is not present within 5 minutes after the time appointed for the
commencement of the meeting, the directors present may choose 1 of their number
to be the chairperson of the meeting.

55 Notice of meeting

(1) A director or, if requested by a director to do so, an employee of the
company, may convene a meeting of directors by giving notice in accordance with
this clause.
(2) Not less than 24 hours notice of a meeting of directors must be given to
every director who is in Niue, or who can readily be contacted outside Niue.
(3) An irregularity in the notice of a meeting is waived if all directors
entitled to receive notice of the meeting attend the meeting without protest as to
the irregularity, or if all directors entitled to receive notice of the meeting agree to
the waiver.

56 Methods of holding meetings

A meeting of directors may be held either –
(a) By a number of the directors who constitute a quorum, being
assembled together at the place, date, and time appointed for the
meeting; or
(b) By means of audio, or audio and visual, communication by which
all directors participating and constituting a quorum, may
simultaneously hear each other throughout the meeting.

57 Quorum

(1) A quorum for a meeting of directors is a majority of the directors.
(2) No business may be transacted at a meeting of directors if a quorum is
not present.

58 Voting

(1) Every director has 1 vote.
(2) The chairperson has a casting vote.
(3) A resolution of the directors is passed if it is agreed to by all directors
present without dissent, or if a majority of the votes cast on it are in favour of it.
(4) A director present at a meeting of directors is presumed to have agreed
to, and to have voted in favour of, a resolution of the directors unless he or she
expressly dissents from, or votes against, the resolution at the meeting.

59 Minutes

The directors must ensure that minutes are kept of all proceedings at
meetings of the directors.

60 Unanimous resolution

(1) A resolution in writing, signed or assented to by all directors, is as valid
and effective as if it had been passed at a meeting of the directors duly convened
and held.
472 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) Any such resolution may consist of several documents (including fax or other similar means of communication) in like form each signed or assented to by 1 or more directors.
(3) A copy of any such resolution must be entered in the minute book of the directors’ proceedings.

61 Managing director and other executive directors

(1) The directors may, from time to time, appoint a director as managing
director for such period and on such terms as they think fit.
(2) Subject to the terms of a managing director ’s appointment, the directors
may at any time cancel the appointment of a director as managing director.
(3) A director who holds office as managing director ceases to hold office
as managing director if he or she ceases to be a director of the company.

62 Delegation to managing director

(1) The directors may delegate to the managing director, subject to any
conditions or restrictions that they consider appropriate, any of their powers that
may be lawfully delegated.
(2) Any such delegation may at any time be withdrawn or varied by the
directors.
(3) The delegation of a power of the directors to the managing director
does not prevent the exercise of the power by the directors, unless the terms of the
delegation expressly provide otherwise.

63 Remuneration of managing director and director

(1) Subject to shareholder approval in accordance with clause 52, the
managing director, or a director (other than the managing director) who is
employed by the company, may be paid such remuneration as he or she may
agree with the directors.
(2) The remuneration may be by way of salary, commission, participation
in profits, or any combination of these methods, or any other method of fixing
remuneration.

64 Company records

PART 4
COMPANY RECORDS
(1) The company must keep all the following documents at its registered office or at some other place notice of which has been given to the Registrar in accordance with section 119 of the Act –
(a) The rules of the company;
(b) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of shareholders within the
last 7 years;
(c) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of directors and directors’
committees within the last 7 years;
(d) The full names and residential and postal addresses of the current
directors;
(e) Copies of all written communications to all shareholders or all
holders of the same class of shares during the last 7 years, including
annual reports made under section 56 of the Act;
(f) Copies of all financial statements required to be completed under
section 130 of the Act for the last 7 completed accounting periods
of the company;

Companies Act 2006

473
(g) The accounting records required by section 129 of the Act for the current accounting period and for the last 7 completed accounting periods of the company;
(h) The share register.
(2) The references in subclause (1)(b), (c), and (e) to 7 years and the
references in subclause (1)(f) and (g) to 7 completed accounting periods include
such lesser periods as the Registrar may approve by notice in writing to the
company, in accordance with section 117(2) of the Act.

65 Form of records

(1) The records of the company must be kept –
(a) In written form; or
(b) In a form or in a manner that allows the documents and information
that comprise the records to be readily accessible so as to be usable
for subsequent reference, and convertible into written form.
(2) The directors must ensure that adequate measures exist to –
(a) Prevent the records being falsified; and
(b) Detect any falsification of them.

66 Access to records

(1) The directors of the company are entitled to access to the company’s
records in accordance with section 120 of the Act.
(2) A shareholder of the company is entitled –
(a) To inspect the documents referred to in section 121 of the Act, in
the manner specified in section 123 of the Act; and
(b) To require copies of, or extracts from, any document that he or she
may inspect within 5 working days of making a request in writing
for the copy or extract, on payment of any reasonable copying and
administration fee prescribed by the company.
(3) The fee may be determined by any director, subject to any directions
from the directors.

67 Documents to be sent to Registrar

In addition to any annual return required under section 124 of the Act, the
company must send all the following documents to the Registrar under the Act –
(a) Notice of the adoption of new rules by the company, or the alteration
of the rules of the company, under section 14 of the Act;
(b) Notice of a change in the registered office or postal address of the
company under section 18 of the Act;
(c) Notice of the issue of shares by the company, under section 26 of
the Act;
(d) Notice of the acquisition by the company of its own shares, under
section 31 of the Act;
(e) Notice of the redemption of a share, under section 35 of the Act;
(f) Notice of a change in the directors of the company, or of a change
in the name or residential address or postal address of a director,
under section 88 of the Act;
(g) Notice of the making of an order under section 102 of the Act altering
or adding to the rules of a company;
(h) Notice of any place other than the registered office of the company
where records are kept, or of any change in the place where records
are kept, under section 119 of the Act;
(i) documents requested by the Registrar under section 311 of the
Act.
474 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

68 Documents to be sent to shareholders

In addition to any annual report required under section 56 of the Act, the
company must send all the following documents to shareholders under the Act –
(a) Notice of any repurchase of shares to which section 31(4) of the Act
applies;
(b) Notice of a written resolution approved under section 52 of the
Act;
(c) Financial statements required to be sent under section 130 of the
Act;
(d) Any written statement by an auditor under section 136 of the Act;
(e) Any report by an auditor under section 138 of the Act.
PART 5
ACCOUNTS AND AUDIT

69 Accounting records to be kept

(1) The directors of the company must cause accounting records to be kept
that –
(a) Correctly record and explain the transactions of the company; and
(b) Will at any time enable the financial position of the company to be
determined with reasonable accuracy; and
(c) Will enable the directors to ensure that the financial statements of
the company comply with section 130 of the Act; and
(d) Will enable the financial statements of the company to be readily
and properly audited.
(2) Without limiting clause 68, the accounting records must contain –
(a) Entries of money received and spent each day and the matters to
which it relates; and
(b) A record of the assets and liabilities of the company; and
(c) If the company’s business involves dealing in goods –
(i) a record of goods bought and sold, and relevant invoices;
(ii) a record of stock held at the end of the financial year together
with records of any stocktakings during the year; and
(d) If the company’s business involves providing services, a record of
services provided and relevant invoices.
(3) If the company sells goods or provides services for cash in the ordinary
course of carrying on a retail business –
(a) Invoices need not be kept in respect of each retail transaction for
the purposes of subclause (2); and
(b) A record of the total money received each day in respect of the sale
of goods or provision of services, as the case may be, is sufficient to
comply with subclause (2) in respect of those transactions.
(4) The accounting records must be kept –
(a) In a form permitted under clause 65; and
(b) At the registered office of the company, or any other place permitted
under section 119 of the Act.

70 Financial statements to be prepared

(1) The directors must ensure that –
(a) Within 4 months after the balance date of the company, or with the
approval of shareholders by special resolution, within an extended
period not exceeding 7 months after the balance date of the
company, financial statements that comply with subclause (2) are
completed in relation to the company and that balance date; and

Companies Act 2006

475
(b) Within 20 working days of the date on which the financial statements must be completed under paragraph (a), those financial statements are sent to all shareholders. This requirement may be satisfied by sending the financial statements to shareholders in an annual report, in accordance with section 56 of the Act.
(2) The financial statements of the company must –
(a) Give a true and fair view of the matters to which they relate; and
(b) Comply with any applicable regulations made under the Act; and
(c) Be dated and signed on behalf of the directors by 2 directors of the
company, or, if the company has only 1 director, by that director.
(3) The following periods must not exceed 15 months –
(a) The period between the date of incorporation of the company and
its first balance date;
(b) The period between any 2 balance dates of the company.
(4) In this clause, financial statements, in relation to the company and a
balance date, means –
(a) A statement of financial position for the entity as at the balance
date; and
(b) In the case of –
(i) a company trading for profit, a statement of financial
performance for the company in relation to the accounting
period ending at the balance date; and
(ii) a company not trading for profit, an income and expenditure
statement for the company in relation to the accounting period
ending at the balance date; and
(c) If required by regulations made under the Act, a statement of cash
flows for the company in relation to the accounting period ending
on the balance date; and
(d) Such other financial statements in relation to the company or any
group of companies of which it is the holding company as may be
required by regulations made under the Act; and
(e) Any notes or documents giving information relating to the
statement of financial position and other statements.

71 Appointment of auditor

(1) If required to do so under subclause (2), the company must appoint an
auditor who is qualified to hold that office under section 135 of the Act to –
(a) Audit the financial statements of the company in respect of an
accounting period; and
(b) Hold office until those financial statements have been audited in
accordance with the Act or until he or she ceases to hold office under
subclause (3).
(2) The company must appoint an auditor within 30 working days if –
(a) A shareholder or shareholders holding shares that together carry
the right to receive more than 20% of distributions made by the
company give written notice to the company before the end of an
accounting period requiring the financial statements of the company
for that period to be audited; or
(b) A vacancy in the office of auditor arises before the financial
statements in respect of a period for which an audit is required
have been audited.
476 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) An auditor ceases to hold office if he or she –
(a) Resigns by delivering a written notice of resignation to the registered
office of the company not less than 20 working days before the date
on which the notice is expressed to be effective; or
(b) Is replaced as auditor by an ordinary resolution appointing another
person as auditor in his or her place, following notice to the auditor
in accordance with section 133 of the Act; or
(c) Becomes disqualified from being the auditor of the company under
section 135 of the Act; or
(d) Dies; or
(e) Becomes subject to a trustee order under section 501 of the Niue
Act 1966, or an order of medical custody under section 602 of that
Act; or
(f) Ceases to hold office under subclause (5); or
(g) Is removed by all shareholders in accordance with subclause (6).
(4) An auditor may be appointed –
(a) By ordinary resolution; or
(b) If the office of auditor is vacant, by the directors. If an auditor is
appointed by the directors, the directors must, within 10 working
days, give notice of the appointment to all shareholders.
(5) If the company is required to appoint an auditor in respect of an
accounting period but is not required to do so in respect of a subsequent accounting
period –
(a) The audit of the financial statements of the company for the accounting period in respect of which an audit is required must be completed in accordance with this section; and
(b) The directors may give notice to all shareholders within 4 months
of the commencement of a subsequent accounting period that the
company is no longer required to appoint an auditor, and that the
auditor will cease to hold office unless a notice is given by
shareholders under subclause (2)(a) by a date specified in the notice,
which must be not less than 30 working days from the date on which
the notice is given; and
(c) If a notice has been given under paragraph (b), and no notice under
subclause (2)(a) is received by the company by the date specified in
that notice, the auditor ceases to hold office on the later of –
(i) the date specified in the notice; or
(ii) the date on which the audit of the financial statements of the
company for the previous accounting period is completed.
(6) Despite the other provisions of this clause, all shareholders may agree,
in writing –
(a) To dispense with an audit for any accounting period; and
(b) To remove the auditor of the company.
(7) The fees payable to the auditor must be agreed between the auditor
and the directors.

Companies Act 2006

477

72 Auditor’s attendance at shareholders’ meeting

The directors must ensure that an auditor of the company –
(a) Is permitted to attend a meeting of shareholders of the company;
and
(b) Receives the notices and communications that a shareholder is
entitled to receive relating to meetings and resolutions of
shareholders; and
(c) May be heard at a meeting of shareholders that he or she attends
on any part of the business of the meeting that concerns him or her
as auditor.
PART 6
LIQUIDATION AND REMOVAL FROM REGISTER

73 Resolution to appoint liquidator

(1) The shareholders may resolve to liquidate the company by special
resolution.
(2) The directors may resolve to liquidate the company at a meeting called
under section 71 of the Act, if they consider that the company is unable to meet its
debts as they become due in the normal course of business.

74 Distribution of surplus assets

(1) The surplus assets of the company available for distribution to
shareholders after all creditors of the company have been paid must be distributed
in proportion to the number of shares held by each shareholder, subject to the
terms of issue of any shares.
(2) The liquidator may, with the approval of a special resolution, distribute
the surplus assets of the company among the shareholders in kind. For this purpose,
the liquidator may set such value as he or she considers fair on any property to be
divided, and may determine how the division will be carried out as between the
shareholders or different classes of shareholders.
PART 7
MISCELLANEOUS

75 Service of documents on shareholders

(1) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder who is a natural person may be –
(a) Delivered to that person; or
(b) Posted to that person’s postal address; or
(c) Faxed to a fax number used by that person.
(2) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder that is a company or an overseas company may be sent by any of the
methods of serving documents referred to in sections 342 or 344 of the Act, as the
case may be.

76 Interpretation

(1) In these rules, Act means the Companies Act 2005.
(2) Unless the context otherwise requires, any term or expression that is
defined in the Act or any regulations made under the Act and used, but not defined,
in these rules has the same meaning as in the Act or the regulations.
––––––––––––––––––––
478 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
SCHEDULE 3
MODEL RULES FOR SINGLE SHAREHOLDER COMPANY
s 15(3)

PART 1

GENERAL PROVISIONS

1

Name of company

2

Private company with 1 shareholder

3

Rules

PART 2

SHARES AND SHAREHOLDERS

4

Shares

5

Company to keep share register

6

Form and location of share register

7

Status of registered shareholder

8

Transfer of shares

9

Share certificates

10

Shareholder decisions and exercise of

shareholder powers

11

Distributions to shareholders

12

Company may acquire its own shares and

provide financial assistance

13

Annual report to shareholders

PART 3

DIRECTORS

14

Appointment and removal of directors

15

Powers and duties of directors

16

Standard of care of directors

17

Obligations of directors in connection with

insolvency

18

Interested directors

19

Use and disclosure of company information

20

Indemnities and insurance for directors or

employees

21

Remuneration of directors

22

Procedure at meetings of directors

23

Chairperson

1 Name of company

PART 1
GENERAL PROVISIONS
(1) The name of the company at the time of registration under the Act appears on the application for registration or for reregistration, as the case may be.
(2) The name of the company may be changed in accordance with section
11 of the Act only with the prior approval of the shareholder.

2 Private company with 1 shareholder

(1) The company is a private company.
(2) The company must not offer any of its shares or other securities to the
public.

Companies Act 2006

479
(3) The company has 1 shareholder.
(4) These rules are designed for a company with 1 shareholder; if the
company proposes to increase the number of shareholders, it must first adopt
new rules.
(5) The company must not have more than 1 shareholder.
(6) If a share transfer is presented to the company for entry on the share
register that would result in a breach of this restriction, the directors must decline
to register the transfer.

3 Rules

(1) The company may adopt new rules in place of these rules by special
resolution, in accordance with section 14(2) of the Act.
(2) Subject to the Act –
(a) These rules have effect and may be enforced as if they constituted a
contract –
(i) between the company and the shareholder; and
(ii) between the company and each director; and
(b) The shareholder and the directors of the company have the rights,
powers, duties, and obligations set out in these rules.

4 Shares

PART 2
SHARES AND SHAREHOLDERs
(1) At the time of registration under the Act, the company has the number of shares specified in the application for registration or reregistration, as the case may be.
(2) If the company was first registered under Part 2 of the Act, the company
must immediately after its registration issue to the person named in the application
for registration as the shareholder the number of shares specified in the application
as being the number of shares to be issued to that person.
(3) With the prior approval of the shareholder, the company may –
(a) Issue shares to the shareholder; and
(b) Issue more than 1 class of shares.
(4) If the company issues shares, it must give the prescribed notice to the
Registrar under section 26(2) of the Act within 10 working days of the issue of any
shares.
(5) If the rights attached to the shares differ from those set out in section 23 of the Act, the notice must be accompanied by a document setting out the terms of issue of the shares.
(6) The shares of the company are, subject to clause 8(4) and their terms of issue, transferable by entry in the share register in accordance with clause 8(1) to (3).

5 Company to keep share register

(1) The company must maintain a share register that records the shares
issued by the company and states –
(a) The names, alphabetically arranged, and the latest known address
of each person who is, or has within the last 7 years been, a
shareholder; and
(b) The number of shares of each class held by each shareholder within
the last 7 years; and
480 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) The date of any –
(i) issue of shares to; or
(ii) repurchase or redemption of shares from; or
(iii) transfer of shares by or to –
each shareholder within the last 7 years, and in relation to the transfer, the name
of the person to or from whom the shares were transferred.
(2) No notice of a trust, whether express, implied, or constructive, may be
entered on the share register.
(3) The company may appoint an agent to maintain the share register.

6 Form and location of share register

The share register must be kept –
(a) In a form that complies with clause 32; and
(b) At the company’s registered office, or at any other place in Niue
notice of which has been given to the Registrar under section 119 of
the Act.

7 Status of registered shareholder

(1) The company must treat the registered holder of a share as the only
person entitled to –
(a) Exercise the right to vote attaching to the share; and
(b) Receive notices; and
(c) Receive a distribution in respect of the share; and
(d) Exercise the other rights and powers attaching to the share.
(2) If a shareholder dies, that shareholder ’s legal representative is the only
person recognised by the company as having any title to, or interest in, the share.
(3) Any person who becomes entitled to a share as a consequence of the
death, bankruptcy or insolvency or incapacity of a shareholder may be registered
as the holder of that shareholder ’s shares on making a request in writing to the
company to be so registered, accompanied by proof satisfactory to the directors of
that entitlement.

8 Transfer of shares

(1) If shares are to be transferred, a form of transfer signed by the holder
or by his or her agent or attorney must be delivered to the company.
(2) The personal representative of a deceased shareholder may transfer a
share even though the personal representative is not a shareholder at the time of
transfer.
(3) Subject to subclause (4), the company must, immediately on receipt of
a properly executed share transfer, enter the name of the transferee in the share
register as holder of the shares transferred.
(4) If any amount payable to the company by the shareholder is due but
unpaid, the directors may resolve to refuse to register a transfer of a share within
30 working days of receipt of the transfer.
(5) If the directors resolve to refuse to register a transfer under subclause
(4), they must give notice of the refusal to the shareholder within 5 working days
of the date of the resolution.

9 Share certificates

(1) The shareholder may apply to the company for a share certificate
relating to some or all of the shareholder ’s shares in the company.

Companies Act 2006

481
(2) On receipt of an application for a share certificate, the company must, within 20 working days after receiving the application –
(a) If the application relates to some but not all of the shares, separate the shares shown in the register as owned by the shareholder into separate parcels: 1 parcel being the shares to which the share certificate relates, and the other parcel being any remaining shares; and
(b) In all cases send to the shareholder a certificate stating – (i) the name of the company; and
(ii) the class of shares held by the shareholder; and
(iii) the number of shares held by the shareholder to which the
certificate relates.
(3) If a share certificate has been issued, a transfer of the shares to which it
relates must not be registered by the company unless the form of transfer required
by that section is accompanied by –
(a) The share certificate relating to the share; or
(b) Evidence as to its loss or destruction and, if required, an indemnity
in a form determined by the directors.
(4) If shares to which a share certificate relates are to be transferred, and
the share certificate is sent to the company to enable the registration of the transfer,
the share certificate must be cancelled and no further share certificate issued except
at the request of the transferee.

10 Shareholder decisions and exercise of shareholder powers

A resolution in writing signed by the shareholder is as valid as if it had
been passed at a meeting of shareholders.

11 Distributions to shareholders

(1) The payment of a dividend or the making of any other distribution
must be approved by the shareholder.
(2) The company must not make a distribution to the shareholder unless
there are reasonable grounds for believing that, after that distribution is made –
(a) The company will be able to pay its debts as they become due in
the normal course of business; and
(b) The value of the company’s assets will not be less than the value of
its liabilities.
(3) A distribution made in breach of subclause (2) may be recovered by the
company from the shareholder, in accordance with section 29 of the Act.

12 Company may acquire its own shares and provide financial assistance

(1) The company may agree to acquire its own shares from the shareholder,
subject to the solvency test in clause 11(2).
(2) If the company acquires its own shares, those shares are deemed to be
cancelled immediately on acquisition.
(3) The company may give financial assistance to the shareholder for the
purpose of, or in connection with, the purchase of a share issued or to be issued
by the company, whether directly or indirectly, only if after providing the assistance
the company will satisfy the solvency test in clause 11(2).

13 Annual report to shareholders

The directors of the company are not required to prepare an annual report
in respect of any accounting period, unless requested to do so by the shareholder
by notice in writing.
482 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
PART 3
DIRECTORS

14 Appointment and removal of directors

(1) The shareholder may fix the number of directors of the company by
notice in writing to the company.
(2) A director may be appointed or removed by the shareholder by notice
in writing to the company.
(3) A director vacates office if he or she –
(a) Is removed from office in accordance with subclause (2); or
(b) Resigns in accordance with subclause (4); or
(c) Becomes disqualified from being a director under section 85 of the
Act; or
(d) Dies.
(4) A director may resign by delivering a signed written notice of
resignation to the registered office of the company and to the shareholder. Subject
to subclause (5), the notice is effective when it is received at the registered office,
or at any later time specified in the notice.
(5) If the company has only 1 director, that director may not resign until
that director has given not less than 10 working days’ written notice of the
resignation to the shareholder. A notice of resignation given by the sole director of
the company does not take effect, despite its terms, until the earlier of –
(a) The expiry of 10 working days after written notice of the resignation
has been given to the shareholder; or
(b) The appointment of another director of the company.
(6) The company must ensure that notice in the prescribed form of all the
following is delivered to the Registrar –
(a) A change in the directors of the company, whether as the result of a
director ceasing to hold office or the appointment of a new director,
or both;
(b) A change in the name or the residential address of a director of the
company.
(7) In the case of the appointment of a new director, a consent by that person
to act as a director, in the prescribed form, must also be delivered to the Registrar.

15 Powers and duties of directors

(1) The business and affairs of the company must be managed by, or under
the direction or supervision of, the directors subject to –
(a) Section 50 of the Act, which relates to major transactions; and
(b) Any directions given to the board in writing by the shareholder.
(2) The directors have all the powers necessary for managing, and for
directing and supervising the management of, the business and affairs of the
company.
(3) The directors may delegate to a committee of directors, or to a director
or employee, any of their powers. The directors must monitor, by means of
reasonable methods properly used, the exercise of powers by any delegate.
(4) The provisions of these rules relating to proceedings of the directors
also apply to proceedings of any committee of directors, except to the extent the
directors determine otherwise.
(5) The directors have the duties set out in the Act, and, in particular –
(a) Each director must act in good faith and in a manner that the director
believes to be in the interests of the company; and

Companies Act 2006

483
(b) A director must not act, or agree to the company acting, in a manner that contravenes the Act or these rules.

16 Standard of care of directors

A director of the company, when exercising powers or performing duties as a
director, must exercise the care, diligence, and skill that a reasonable person would
exercise in the same circumstances taking into account, but without limitation –
(a) The nature of the company; and
(b) The nature of the decision; and
(c) The position of the director and the nature of the responsibilities
undertaken by him or her.

17 Obligations of directors in connection with insolvency

(1) A director of the company must call a meeting of directors within 10
working days to consider whether the directors should appoint an administrator
or liquidator, in accordance with section 71 of the Act, if the director –
(a) Believes that the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall
due; or
(b) Is aware of matters that would put any reasonable person on inquiry
as to whether the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall
due.
(2) At a meeting called under section 71 of the Act, the directors must
consider whether to –
(a) Appoint an administrator or liquidator; or
(b) Continue to carry on the business of the company.

18 Interested directors

(1) A director must not exercise any power as a director in circumstances
where that director is directly or indirectly materially interested in the exercise of
that power unless the matter in question has been approved by the shareholder.
(2) A transaction entered into by the company in which a director is directly
or indirectly materially interested is voidable at the election of the company in
accordance with section 111 of the Act.
(3) A transaction entered into by the company as the result of action taken
by a director in breach of sections 65, 66, or 67 of the Act is voidable at the option
of the company in accordance with section 112 of the Act.

19 Use and disclosure of company information

A director of the company who has information in his or her capacity as a
director or employee of the company, being information that would not otherwise
be available to him or her, must not disclose that information to any person, or
make use of or act on the information, except –
(a) In the interests of the company; or
(b) As required by law; or
(c) To the shareholder; or
(d) If there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company will
satisfy the solvency test after the director takes that action, and that
action –
(i) is approved by the shareholder; or
(ii) is authorised by any contract of employment entered into
between that director and the company, the relevant terms of
which have been approved by the shareholder.
484 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

20 Indemnities and insurance for directors or employees

(1) Subject to section 74 of the Act, the company may provide an indemnity
or purchase insurance for a director of the company or of a related company with
the approval of the shareholder.
(2) In subclause (1) –
director includes –
(a) A person who is liable under any of sections 65 to 71 of the Act by
virtue of section 73 of the Act; and
(b) A former director
indemnify includes relieve or excuse from liability, whether before or after
the liability arises; and
indemnity has a corresponding meaning.

21 Remuneration of directors

Directors may receive remuneration and other benefits from the company
with the approval of the shareholder.

22 Procedure at meetings of directors

(1) Clauses 23 to 29 set out the procedure to be followed at meetings of
directors.
(2) A meeting of directors may determine its own procedure to the extent
that it is not governed by these rules.

23 Chairperson

(1) The shareholder may appoint a director as chairperson of directors and
may determine the period for which the chairperson is to hold office.
(2) If no chairperson is appointed, or if at a meeting of the directors the
chairperson is not present within 5 minutes after the time appointed for the
commencement of the meeting, the directors present may choose 1 of their number
to be the chairperson of the meeting.

24 Notice of meeting

(1) A director or, if requested by a director to do so, an employee of the
company, may convene a meeting of directors by giving notice in accordance with
this clause.
(2) Not less than 24 hours notice of a meeting of directors must be given to
every director who is in Niue, or who can readily be contacted outside Niue.
(3) An irregularity in the notice of a meeting is waived if all directors
entitled to receive notice of the meeting attend the meeting without protest as to
the irregularity, or if all directors entitled to receive notice of the meeting agree to
the waiver.

25 Methods of holding meetings

A meeting of directors may be held either –
(a) By a number of the directors who constitute a quorum, being
assembled together at the place, date, and time appointed for the
meeting; or
(b) By means of audio, or audio and visual, communication by which
all directors participating and constituting a quorum, may
simultaneously hear each other throughout the meeting.

Companies Act 2006

485

26 Quorum

(1) A quorum for a meeting of directors is a majority of the directors.
(2) No business may be transacted at a meeting of directors if a quorum is
not present.

27 Voting

(1) Every director has 1 vote.
(2) The chairperson has a casting vote.
(3) A resolution of the board is passed if it is agreed to by all directors
present without dissent, or if a majority of the votes cast on it are in favour of it.
(4) A director present at a meeting of directors is presumed to have agreed
to, and to have voted in favour of, a resolution of the directors unless he or she
expressly dissents from, or votes against, the resolution at the meeting.

28 Minutes

The directors must ensure that minutes are kept of all proceedings at
meetings of the directors.

29 Unanimous resolution

(1) A resolution in writing signed or assented to by all directors is as valid
and effective as if it had been passed at a meeting of the directors duly convened
and held.
(2) Any such resolution may consist of several documents (including fax
or other similar means of communication) in like form each signed or assented to
by 1 or more directors.
(3) A copy of any such resolution must be entered in the minute book of
the directors’ proceedings.

30 Managing director and other executive directors

(1) The shareholder may from time to time appoint a director as managing
director for such period and on such terms as the shareholder thinks fit.
(2) The remuneration of the managing director must be approved by the
shareholder.
(3) Subject to the terms of a managing director ’s appointment, the
shareholder may at any time cancel the appointment of a director as managing
director.
(4) A director who holds office as managing director ceases to hold office
as managing director if he or she ceases to be a director of the company.
(5) The directors may, with the prior approval of the shareholder, delegate
to the managing director, subject to any conditions or restrictions that they consider
appropriate, any of their powers that may be lawfully delegated.
(6) Any such delegation may at any time be withdrawn or varied by the
directors. The delegation of a power of the directors to the managing director
does not prevent the exercise of the power by the directors, unless the terms of the
delegation expressly provide otherwise.
(7) A director other than the managing director who is employed by the
company may be paid such remuneration as may be approved by the shareholder.
486 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

31 Company records

PART 4
COMPANY RECORDS
(1) The company must keep all the following documents at its registered office or at some other place notice of which has been given to the Registrar in accordance with section 119 of the Act –
(a) The rules of the company;
(b) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of shareholders within the
last 7 years;
(c) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of directors and directors’
committees within the last 7 years;
(d) The full names and residential and postal addresses of the current
directors;
(e) Copies of all written communications to all shareholders or all
holders of the same class of shares during the last 7 years, including
annual reports made under section 56 of the Act;
(f) Copies of all financial statements required to be completed under
section 130 for the last 7 completed accounting periods of the
company;
(g) The accounting records required by section 129 for the current
accounting period and for the last 7 completed accounting periods
of the company;
(h) The share register.
(2) The references in subclause (1)(b), (c), and (e) to 7 years and the
references in subclause (1)(f) and (g) to 7 completed accounting periods include
any lesser periods that the Registrar may approve by notice in writing to the
company, in accordance with section 117(2) of the Act.

32 Form of records

(1) The records of the company must be kept –
(a) In written form; or
(b) In a form or in a manner that allows the documents and information
that comprise the records to be readily accessible so as to be usable
for subsequent reference, and convertible into written form.
(2) The directors must ensure that adequate measures exist to –
(a) Prevent the records being falsified; and
(b) Detect any falsification of them.

33 Access to records

(1) The directors of the company are entitled to access to the company’s
records in accordance with section 120 of the Act.
(2) The shareholder of the company is entitled to access to the company’s
records as if that shareholder were a director.

34 Documents to be sent to Registrar

In addition to the annual return required under section 124 of the Act, the company
must send all the following documents to the Registrar under the Act –
(a) Notice of the adoption of new rules by the company, or the alteration
of the rules of the company, under section 14 of the Act;
(b) Notice of a change in the registered office of the company, under
section 18 of the Act;

Companies Act 2006

487
(c) Notice of the issue of shares by the company, under section 26 of the Act;
(d) Notice of the acquisition by the company of its own shares, under section 31 of the Act;
(e) Notice of the redemption of a share, under section 35 of the Act;
(f) Notice of a change in the directors of the company, or of a change
in the name or residential address or postal address of a director,
under section 88 of the Act;
(g) Notice of the making of an order under section 102 of the Act altering
or adding to the rules of a company;
(h) Notice of any place other than the registered office of the company
where records are kept, or of any change in the place where records
are kept, under section 119 of the Act;
(i) Documents requested by the Registrar under the Act.

35 Documents to be sent to shareholders

In addition to any annual report required under section 56 of the Act, the
company must send all the following documents to the shareholder under the
Act –
(a) Financial statements required to be sent under section 130 of the
Act;
(b) Any written statement by an auditor under section 136 of the Act;
(c) Any report by an auditor under section 138 of the Act.
PART 5
ACCOUNTS AND AUDIT

36 Accounting records to be kept

(1) The directors of the company must cause accounting records to be kept
that –
(a) Correctly record and explain the transactions of the company; and
(b) Will at any time enable the financial position of the company to be
determined with reasonable accuracy; and
(c) Will enable the directors to ensure that the financial statements of
the company comply with section 130 of the Act; and
(d) Will enable the financial statements of the company to be readily
and properly audited.
(2) Without limiting subclause (1), the accounting records must contain –
(a) Entries of money received and spent each day and the matters to
which it relates; and
(b) A record of the assets and liabilities of the company; and
(c) If the company’s business involves dealing in goods –
(i) a record of goods bought and sold, and relevant invoices; and
(ii) a record of stock held at the end of the financial year together
with records of any stocktakings during the year; and
(d) If the company’s business involves providing services, a record of
services provided and relevant invoices.
(3) If the company sells goods or provides services for cash in the ordinary
course of carrying on a retail business –
(a) Invoices need not be kept in respect of each retail transaction for
the purposes of subclause (2); and
(b) A record of the total money received each day in respect of the sale
of goods or provision of services, as the case may be, is sufficient to
488 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
comply with subclause (2) in respect of those transactions. (4) The accounting records must be kept –
(a) In a form permitted under clause 32; and
(b) At the registered office of the company, or any other place permitted
under section 119 of the Act.

37 Financial statements to be prepared

(1) The directors of every company must ensure that within 4 months after
the balance date of the company or, if the shareholder agrees in writing, within an
extended period not exceeding 7 months after the balance date of the company,
financial statements that comply with subclause (2) are –
(a) Completed in relation to the company and that balance date; and
(b) Given to the shareholder.
(2) The financial statements of the company must –
(a) Give a true and fair view of the matters to which they relate; and
(b) Comply with any applicable regulations made under the Act; and
(c) Be dated and signed on behalf of the directors by 2 directors of the
company, or, if the company has only 1 director, by that director.
(3) The period between –
(a) The date of incorporation of the company and its first balance date;
or
(b) Any 2 balance dates of the company –
must not exceed 15 months.
(4) In this clause, financial statements, in relation to the company and a
balance date, means –
(a) A statement of financial position for the entity as at the balance
date; and
(b) In the case of –
(i) a company trading for profit, a statement of financial
performance for the company in relation to the accounting
period ending at the balance date; and
(ii) a company not trading for profit, an income and expenditure
statement for the company in relation to the accounting period
ending at the balance date; and
(c) If required by regulations made under the Act, a statement of cash
flows for the company in relation to the accounting period ending
on the balance date; and
(d) Such other financial statements in relation to the company or any
group of companies of which it is the holding company as may be
required by regulations made under the Act; and
(e) Any notes or documents giving information relating to the
statement of financial position and other statements.

38 Appointment of auditor

(1) The shareholder may, by notice in writing to the company, appoint an
auditor who is qualified to hold that office under section 135 of the Act to –
(a) Hold office as auditor for the period specified in the notice; and
(b) Audit the financial statements of the company.
(2) The shareholder may remove an auditor by notice in writing to the
company and to that auditor.

Companies Act 2006

489

39 Auditor’s attendance at shareholders’ meeting

The directors of the company must ensure that an auditor of the company –
(a) Is permitted to attend a meeting of shareholders of the company;
and
(b) Receives the notices and communications that a shareholder is
entitled to receive relating to meetings and resolutions of
shareholders; and
(c) May be heard at a meeting of shareholders that he or she attends
on any part of the business of the meeting that concerns him or her
as auditor.
PART 6
LIQUIDATION AND REMOVAL FROM REGISTER

40 Resolution to appoint liquidator

(1) The shareholder may resolve to liquidate the company by special
resolution.
(2) The directors may resolve to liquidate the company at a meeting called
under section 71 of the Act if they consider that the company is unable to meet its
debts as they become due in the normal course of business.
(3) The directors must give not less than 5 working days’ notice to the
shareholder of any meeting called under section 71 of the Act, and must permit
the shareholder to attend and speak at that meeting.

41 Distribution of surplus assets

(1) The surplus assets of the company available for distribution to
shareholders after all creditors of the company have been paid must be distributed
to the shareholder.
(2) The liquidator may, with the approval of the shareholder, distribute
the surplus assets of the company to the shareholder in kind.
PART 7
MISCELLANEOUS

42 Service of documents on shareholder

(1) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder who is a natural person may be –
(a) Delivered to that person; or
(b) Sent by any other method approved in writing by that shareholder.
(2) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder that is a company or an overseas company may be sent by any of the
methods of serving documents referred to in sections 342 or 344 of the Act, as the
case may be.

43 Interpretation

(1) In these rules, Act means the Companies Act 2005.
(2) Unless the context otherwise requires, any term or expression that is
defined in the Act or any regulations made under the Act and used, but not defined,
in these rules has the same meaning as in the Act or the regulations.
490 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
Schedule 4 s 15(2)
Model rules for public companies

PART 1

GENERAL PROVISIONS

1 Name of company

2 Public company

3 Rules

PART 2

SHARES AND SHAREHOLDERS

General provisions

4 Number of shares

5 Rights attaching to shares

6 Initial issue of shares

7 Process for issuing shares

8 Transferability of shares

Share register

9 Company to keep share register

10 Form and location of share register

11 Status of registered shareholders

Transfer of shares and share certificates

12 Transfer of shares

13 Share certificates

Meetings of shareholders

14 Meetings of shareholders

15 Notice of meetings

16 Methods of holding meetings

17 Quorum

18 Chairperson

19 Voting

20 Votes of joint shareholders

21 Proxies

22 Corporations may act by representatives

23 Postal votes

24 Duty of person authorised to receive and

count postal votes

25 Duty of chairperson concerning postal

votes

26 Minutes

Miscellaneous

27 Annual meetings and special meetings of

shareholders

28 Written resolutions of shareholders

29 Voting in interest groups

30 Shareholders entitled to receive dividends

31 Notice of meetings and voting

32 Distributions to shareholders

33 Company may acquire its own shares and

provide financial assistance

34 Annual report to shareholders

Companies Act 2006

491

72

Managing director and other executive

81

Financial statements to be prepared

directors

82

Appointment of auditor

73

Delegation to managing director

83

Auditor ’s attendance at shareholders’

74

Remuneration of managing director and

meeting

executive directors

PART 6

PART 4

LIQUIDATION AND REMOVAL FROM REGISTER

COMPANY RECORDS

84

Resolution to appoint liquidator

75

Company records

85

Distribution of surplus assets

76

Form of records

77

Access to records

PART 7

78

Documents to be sent to Registrar

MISCELLANEOUS

79

Documents to be sent to shareholders

86

Service of documents on shareholders

87

Interpretation

PART 5

ACCOUNTS AND AUDIT

80

Accounting records to be kept

––––––––––––––––––––

1 Name of company

PART 1
GENERAL PROVISIONS
(1) The name of the company at the time of registration under the Act appears on the application for registration or for reregistration, as the case may be.
(2) The name of the company may be changed in accordance with section
10 of the Act with the prior approval of the directors.

2 Public company

The company is a public company.

3 Rules

(1) The company may adopt new rules in place of these rules by special
resolution, in accordance with section 14(2) of the Act.
(2) Subject to the Act –
(a) These rules have effect and may be enforced as if they constituted a
contract –
(i) between the company and its shareholders; and
(ii) between the company and each director; and
(b) The shareholders and directors of the company have the rights,
powers, duties, and obligations set out in these rules.

4 Number of shares

PART 2
SHARES AND SHAREHOLDERS

General provisions

At the time of registration under the Act the company has the number of shares specified in the application for registration or reregistration, as the case may be.
492 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

5 Rights attaching to shares

Subject to clause 7(4), each share carries all the following rights –
(a) The right to 1 vote on a poll at a meeting of the company on any
resolution, including any resolution to –
(i) appoint or remove a director or auditor;
(ii) adopt new rules;
(iii) alter the company’s rules;
(iv) approve a major transaction;
(v) approve an amalgamation of the company;
(vi) approve reregistration of a public company as a private
company, or of a private company as a public company;
(vii) put the company into liquidation;
(viii) approve the transfer of registration of the company to another
country; and
(b) The right to an equal share in dividends paid by the company; and
(c) The right to an equal share in the distribution of the surplus assets
of the company in a liquidation.

6 Initial issue of shares

If the company was first registered under Part 2 of the Act, the company
must immediately after its registration issue to any person named in the application
for registration as a shareholder the number of shares specified in the application
as being the number of shares to be issued to that person or those persons.

7 Process for issuing shares

(1) The directors may issue shares –
(a) Pursuant to an offer made to all shareholders proportionally, that,
if accepted by all shareholders, would not affect relative voting or
distribution rights, on such terms as the directors think fit (including
issuing shares without consideration, or instead of dividends). The
shareholders must have a reasonable opportunity to consider and
respond to the offer; or
(b) To shareholders or any other persons for a consideration determined
by the directors. The directors must use reasonable endeavours to
obtain the best price reasonably obtainable for those shares.
(2) The directors may issue more than 1 class of shares. In particular, shares
may be issued that –
(a) Are redeemable; or
(b) Confer preferential rights to distributions of capital or income; or
(c) Confer special, limited, or conditional voting rights; or
(d) Do not confer voting rights.
(3) If the company issues shares, it must give the prescribed notice to the
Registrar under section 26(2) of the Act within 10 working days of the issue of any
shares.
(4) If the rights attached to the shares differ from those set out in clause 5, the notice must be accompanied by a document setting out the terms of issue of the shares.

8 Transferability of shares

The shares of the company are, subject to clause 7(4) and their terms of
issue, transferable by entry in the share register in accordance with clauses 12(1)
to (3).

Companies Act 2006

493

Share register

9 Company to keep share register

(1) The company must maintain a share register that records the shares
issued by the company and states –
(a) The names, alphabetically arranged, and the last known address of
each person who is, or has within the last 7 years been, a shareholder;
and
(b) The number of shares of each class held by each shareholder within
the last 7 years; and
(c) The date of any –
(i) issue of shares to; or
(ii) repurchase or redemption of shares from; or
(iii) transfer of shares by or to –
each shareholder within the last 7 years, and in relation to the transfer, the name
of the person to or from whom the shares were transferred.
(2) No notice of a trust, whether express, implied, or constructive, may be
entered on the share register.
(3) The company may appoint an agent to maintain the share register.

10 Form and location of share register

The share register must be kept –
(a) iIn a form that complies with clause 76; and
(b) At the company’s registered office, or at any other place in Niue
notice of which has been given to the Registrar under section 119 of
the Act.

11 Status of registered shareholders

(1) The company must treat the registered holder of a share as the only
person entitled to –
(a) Exercise the right to vote attaching to the share; and
(b) Receive notices; and
(c) Receive a distribution in respect of the share; and
(d) Exercise the other rights and powers attaching to the share.
(2) If a joint holder of a share dies, the remaining holders must be treated
by the company as the holders of that share.
(3) If the sole holder of a share dies, that shareholder ’s legal representative
is the only person recognised by the company as having any title to or interest in
the share.
(4) Any person who becomes entitled to a share as a consequence of the
death, bankruptcy or insolvency or incapacity of a shareholder may be registered
as the holder of that shareholder ’s shares on making a request in writing to the
company to be so registered, accompanied by proof satisfactory to the directors of
that entitlement.

Transfer of shares and share certificates

12 Transfer of shares

(1) If shares are to be transferred, a form of transfer signed by the holder
or by his or her agent or attorney must be delivered to the company.
(2) The personal representative of a deceased shareholder may transfer a
share even though the personal representative is not a shareholder at the time of
transfer.
494 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) Subject to subclause (4), the company must, immediately on receipt of a properly executed share transfer, enter the name of the transferee in the share register as holder of the shares transferred.
(4) The directors may resolve to refuse to register a transfer of a share within
30 working days of receipt of the transfer, if any amount payable to the company
by the shareholder is due but unpaid.
(5) If the directors resolve to refuse to register a transfer for this reason,
they must give notice of the refusal to the shareholder within 5 working days of
the date of the resolution.

13 Share certificates

(1) A shareholder may apply to the company for a share certificate relating
to some or all of the shareholder ’s shares in the company.
(2) On receipt of an application for a share certificate under subclause (1),
the company must, within 20 working days after receiving the application –
(a) If the application relates to some but not all of the shares, separate
the shares shown in the register as owned by the applicant into
separate parcels; 1 parcel being the shares to which the share
certificate relates, and the other parcel being any remaining shares;
and
(b) In all cases send to the shareholder a certificate stating –
(i) the name of the company; and
(ii) the class of shares held by the shareholder; and
(iii) the number of shares held by the shareholder to which the
certificate relates.
(3) If a share certificate has been issued, a transfer of the shares to which it
relates must not be registered by the company unless the form of transfer required
by that section is accompanied by –
(a) The share certificate relating to the share; or
(b) Evidence as to its loss or destruction and, if required, an indemnity
in a form determined by the directors.
(4) If shares to which a share certificate relates are to be transferred, and
the share certificate is sent to the company to enable the registration of the transfer,
the share certificate must be cancelled and no further share certificate issued except
at the request of the transferee.

Meetings of shareholders

14 Meetings of shareholders

(1) Clauses 15 to 27 set out the procedure to be followed at, and in relation
to, meetings of shareholders.
(2) A meeting of shareholders may determine its own procedure to the
extent that it is not governed by these rules.

15 Notice of meetings

(1) Written notice of the time and place of a meeting of shareholders must
be given to every shareholder entitled to receive notice of the meeting and to
every director and any auditor of the company not less than 15 working days
before the meeting.
(2) The notice must set out –
(a) The nature of the business to be transacted at the meeting in
sufficient detail to enable a shareholder to form a reasoned judgment
in relation to it; and

Companies Act 2006

495
(b) The text of any special resolution to be submitted to the meeting. (3) An irregularity in a notice of a meeting is waived if all the shareholders
entitled to attend and vote at the meeting attend the meeting without protest as to the irregularity, or if all such shareholders agree to the waiver.
(4) An accidental omission to give notice of a meeting to, or the failure to receive notice of a meeting by, a shareholder does not invalidate the proceedings at that meeting.
(5) If a meeting of shareholders is adjourned for less than 30 working days, it is not necessary to give notice of the time and place of the adjourned meeting other than by announcement at the meeting that is adjourned.

16 Methods of holding meetings

A meeting of shareholders may be held either –
(a) By a number of shareholders, who constitute a quorum, being
assembled together at the place, date, and time appointed for the
meeting; or
(b) By means of audio, or audio and visual, communication by which
all shareholders participating and constituting a quorum, may
simultaneously hear each other throughout the meeting.

17 Quorum

(1) Subject to subclause (3), no business may be transacted at a meeting of
shareholders if a quorum is not present.
(2) A quorum for a meeting of shareholders is present if 5 or more
shareholders or their proxies are present who are between them able to exercise a
majority of the votes to be cast on the business to be transacted by the meeting.
(3) If a quorum is not present within 30 minutes after the time appointed
for the meeting, the meeting is adjourned to the same day in the following week
at the same time and place, or to such other date, time and place as the directors
may appoint.
(4) If, at the adjourned meeting, a quorum is not present within 30 minutes
after the time appointed for the meeting, the shareholders present or their proxies
are a quorum.

18 Chairperson

(1) If the directors have elected a chairperson of the directors, and the
chairperson of the directors is present at a meeting of shareholders, he or she
must chair the meeting.
(2) If no chairperson of the directors has been elected or if, at any meeting
of shareholders, the chairperson of the directors is not present within 15 minutes
of the time appointed for the commencement of the meeting, the shareholders
present may choose 1 of their number to be the chairperson of the meeting.

19 Voting

(1) In the case of a meeting of shareholders held under clause 16(a), unless
a poll is demanded, voting at the meeting will take place by whichever of the
following methods is determined by the chairperson of the meeting –
(a) Voting by voice;
(b) Voting by show of hands.
(2) In the case of a meeting of shareholders held under clause 16(b), unless
a poll is demanded, voting at the meeting will take place by shareholders signifying
individually their assent or dissent by voice.
496 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) A declaration by the chairperson of the meeting that a resolution is carried by the requisite majority is conclusive evidence of that fact unless a poll is demanded in accordance with subclause (4).
(4) At a meeting of shareholders a poll may be demanded by –
(a) Not fewer than 5 shareholders having the right to vote on the
question at the meeting; or
(b) A shareholder or shareholders representing not less than 10% of
the total voting rights of all shareholders having the right to vote
on the question at the meeting.
(5) A poll may be demanded either before or after a vote is taken on a
resolution.
(6) If a poll is taken, votes must be counted according to the votes attached
to the shares of each shareholder present and voting.
(7) The chairperson of a shareholders’ meeting is not entitled to a casting
vote.

20 Votes of joint shareholders

If 2 or more persons are registered as the holder of a share, the vote of the
person named first in the share register and voting on a matter must be accepted
to the exclusion of the votes of the other joint holders.

21 Proxies

(1) A shareholder may exercise the right to vote either by being present in
person or by proxy.
(2) A proxy for a shareholder is entitled to attend and participate in a
meeting of shareholders as if the proxy were the shareholder.
(3) A proxy must be appointed by notice in writing signed by the
shareholder. The notice must state whether the appointment is for a particular
meeting, or for a specified term.
(4) No proxy is effective in relation to a meeting unless a copy of the notice
of appointment is given to the company at least 24 hours before the start of the
meeting.

22 Corporations may act by representatives

(1) A corporation that is a shareholder may appoint a representative to
attend a meeting of shareholders on its behalf by notice in writing signed by a
director or secretary of the corporation.
(2) The notice must state whether the appointment is for a particular
meeting, or for a specified term.

23 Postal votes

(1) A shareholder may exercise the right to vote at a meeting by casting a
postal vote in accordance with this clause.
(2) The notice of a meeting at which shareholders are entitled to cast a
postal vote must state the name of the person authorised by the directors to receive
and count postal votes at that meeting.
(3) A shareholder may cast a postal vote on all or any of the matters to be
voted on at the meeting by sending a notice of the manner in which his or her
shares are to be voted to a person authorised to receive and count postal votes at
that meeting. The notice must reach that person not less than 48 hours before the
start of the meeting.

Companies Act 2006

497
(4) A shareholder who has submitted a postal vote on any resolution – (a) May attend and speak at the meeting; and
(b) Must not vote on that resolution in person at the meeting.

24 Duty of person authorised to receive and count postal votes

(1) If no person has been authorised to receive and count postal votes at a
meeting, or if no person is named as being so authorised in the notice of the meeting,
every director is deemed to be so authorised.
(2) It is the duty of a person authorised to receive and count postal votes at
a meeting –
(a) To collect together all postal votes received by him or her or by the
company; and
(b) In relation to each resolution to be voted on at the meeting, to count –
(i) the number of shareholders voting in favour of the resolution
and the number of votes cast by each shareholder in favour of
the resolution; and
(ii) the number of shareholders voting against the resolution, and
the number of votes cast by each shareholder against the
resolution; and
(c) To sign a certificate that he or she has carried out the duties set out
in paragraphs (a) and (b) and that sets out the results of the counts
required by paragraph (b); and
(d) To ensure that the certificate required by paragraph (c) is presented
to the chairperson of the meeting.

25 Duty of chairperson concerning postal votes

(1) If a vote is taken at a meeting on a resolution on which postal votes
have been cast, the chairperson of the meeting must –
(a) On a vote by show of hands, count each shareholder who has
submitted a postal vote for or against the resolution; and
(b) On a poll, count the votes cast by each shareholder who has
submitted a postal vote for or against the resolution.
(2) The chairperson of a meeting must call for a poll on a resolution on
which he or she holds sufficient postal votes, that he or she believes, that if a poll
is taken, the result may differ from that obtained on a show of hands.
(3) The chairperson of a meeting must ensure that a certificate of postal
votes held by him or her is annexed to the minutes of the meeting.

26 Minutes

(1) The directors must ensure that minutes are kept of all proceedings at
meetings of shareholders.
(2) Minutes that have been signed correct by the chairperson of the meeting
are prima facie evidence of the proceedings at the meeting.

Miscellaneous

27 Annual meetings and special meetings of shareholders

(1) Subject to subclause (3) and clause 28(3), the directors must call an
annual meeting of the company to be held –
(a) Once in each calendar year; and
(b) Not later than 5 months after the balance date of the company; and
(c) Not later than 15 months after the previous annual meeting.
(2) The meeting must be held on the date on which it is called to be held.
498 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(3) The company need not hold its first annual meeting in the calendar year of its incorporation, but must hold that meeting within 18 months of its incorporation.
(4) A special meeting of shareholders entitled to vote on an issue – (a) May be called at any time by a director; and
(b) Must be called by the directors on the written request of
shareholders holding shares carrying together not less than 5% of
the votes that may be cast on that issue.

28 Written resolutions of shareholders

(1) A resolution in writing signed by shareholders, who together hold not
less than 75% of the votes entitled to be cast on that resolution at a meeting of
shareholders, is as valid as if it had been passed at a meeting of those shareholders.
(2) Any such resolution may consist of several documents (including fax
or other similar means of communication) in like form, each signed or assented to
by 1 or more shareholders.
(3) The company need not hold an annual meeting if everything required
to be done at that meeting (by resolution or otherwise) is done by resolution in
accordance with subclause (1).
(4) Within 5 working days of a resolution being passed under subclause
(1), the company must send a copy of the resolution to every shareholder who did
not sign it.
(5) A resolution may be signed under subclause (1) without any prior notice
being given to shareholders.

29 Voting in interest groups

If the company proposes to take action that affects the rights attached to
shares within the meaning of section 54 of the Act, the action may not be taken
unless it is approved by a special resolution of each interest group, as defined in
section 54(3) of the Act.

30 Shareholders entitled to receive dividends

(1) The shareholders who are entitled to receive dividends are –
(a) If the directors fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders whose
names are registered in the share register on that date;
(b) If the directors do not fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders
whose names are registered in the share register on the day on which
the dividend is approved.
(2) A date fixed under subclause (1)(a) must not precede by more than 20
working days the date on which the proposed action will be taken.

31 Notice of meetings and voting

(1) The shareholders who are entitled to receive notice of a meeting of
shareholders are –
(a) If the directors fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders whose
names are registered in the share register on that date;
(b) If the directors do not fix a date for this purpose, those shareholders
whose names are registered in the share register at the close of
business on the day immediately preceding the day on which the
notice is given.
(2) A date fixed under subclause (1)(a) must not precede by more than 30
working days the date on which the meeting is to be held.

Companies Act 2006

499
(3) Before a meeting of shareholders, the company may prepare a list of shareholders entitled to receive notice of the meeting, arranged in alphabetical order, and showing the number of shares held by each shareholder –
(a) If a date has been fixed under subclause (1)(a), as at that date; or
(b) If no such date has been fixed, as at the close of business on the day
immediately preceding the day on which the notice is given.
(4) A person named in a list prepared under subclause (3) is entitled to
attend the meeting and vote in respect of the shares shown opposite his or her
name in person or by proxy, except to the extent that –
(a) That person has, since the date on which the shareholders entitled
to receive notice of the meeting were determined, transferred any
of his or her shares to some other person; and
(b) The transferee of those shares has been registered as the holder of
those shares, and has requested, before the commencement of the
meeting, that his or her name be entered on the list prepared under
subclause (3).
(5) A shareholder may on 2 working days’ notice examine any list prepared
under subclause (3) during normal business hours at the registered office of the
company.

32 Distributions to shareholders

(1) The company must not pay a dividend or make any other distribution
to shareholders unless there are reasonable grounds for believing that, after that
distribution is made –
(a) The company will be able to pay its debts as they become due in
the normal course of business; and
(b) The value of the company’s assets will not be less than the value of
its liabilities.
(2) Subject to subclause (1) and to the terms of issue of any shares, the
company may pay a dividend to shareholders –
(a) Of the same amount in respect of each share of the same class, if the
payment of the dividend is authorised by the directors; or
(b) On any other basis, with the prior approval of all shareholders.
(3) A distribution made in breach of subclauses (1) or (2) may be recovered
by the company from the recipients or from the persons approving the distribution,
in accordance with section 29 of the Act.
(4) No dividend or other distribution bears interest against the company
unless the applicable terms of issue of a share expressly provide otherwise.
(5) All dividends and other distributions unclaimed for 1 year after the
due date for payment may be invested or otherwise made use of by the directors
for the benefit of the company until claimed.
(6) The company is entitled to mingle the unclaimed distribution with other
money of the company and is not required to hold it or to regard it as being
impressed with any trust but, subject to compliance with the solvency test, must
pay the distribution to the person producing evidence of entitlement to receive it.

33 Company may acquire its own shares and provide financial assistance

(1) Subject to the solvency test, the company may agree to acquire its own
shares from a shareholder –
(a) Pursuant to an offer to acquire shares made to all holders of shares
of the same class that would, if accepted by all persons to whom
the offer is made, leave unaffected relative voting and distribution
rights; or
500 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) On any other basis, with the prior approval of shareholders by special resolution.
(2) If the company acquires its own shares, those shares are deemed to be cancelled immediately on acquisition.
(3) The company may give financial assistance to a person for the purpose of, or in connection with, the purchase of a share issued or to be issued by the company, whether directly or indirectly, only if –
(a) The company gives the assistance in the normal course of its business and on usual terms and conditions; or
(b) The giving of the assistance is authorised by the directors or by all shareholders under section 51 of the Act, and there are reasonable grounds for believing that, after providing the assistance, the company will satisfy the solvency test.

34 Annual report to shareholders

(1) The directors of the company must, within 5 months after the balance
date of the company –
(a) Prepare an annual report on the affairs of the company during the
accounting period ending on that date; and
(b) Send a copy of that report to each shareholder.
(2) Every annual report for the company must –
(a) Be in writing and be dated; and
(b) Include financial statements for the accounting period that comply
with section 130 of the Act; and
(c) Include the auditor ’s report required under section 138 of the Act;
and
(d) State the names of the persons holding office as directors of the
company as at the end of the accounting period and the names of
any persons who ceased to hold office as directors of the company
during the accounting period; and
(e) Contain such other information as may be required by regulations
made under the Act; and
(f) Be signed on behalf of the directors by 2 directors of the company
or, if the company has only 1 director, by that director.

Compulsory acquisitions

35 Compulsory acquisition of minority holdings below 10%

(1) A shareholder who holds 90% of the voting shares of the company
(majority shareholder) may give a notice to the other holders of voting shares
(minority shareholders) in accordance with this clause, requiring the minority
shareholders to sell their voting shares to the majority shareholder.
(2) The majority shareholder must also give the notice to the company,
and give public notice of the fact that such a notice has been given.
(3) A notice may be given under subclause (1) by a majority shareholder at
any time within 6 months after that majority shareholder first becomes interested
in not less than 90% of the voting shares of the company.

Companies Act 2006

501

36 Price for voting share

(1) The majority shareholder must pay a price for each voting share that
is –
(a) Equal to the highest price paid for a voting share by that majority shareholder in an arms length sale and purchase of such shares during the 6-month period ending on the date on which the majority shareholder first became interested in not less than 90% of the voting shares; or
(b) If the majority shareholder so elects, a price to be fixed by an
independent arbitrator.
(2) The majority shareholder must ask the directors of the company to
nominate an independent arbitrator for this purpose.
(3) If the directors fail to do so within 10 working days of receiving such a
request, the majority shareholder may nominate the arbitrator.

37 Notice under clause 35: general requirements

(1) A notice given under clause 35 must specify –
(a) The name of the majority shareholder; and
(b) The date on which the majority shareholder first became interested
in not less than 90% of the voting shares of the company; and
(c) If the price to be paid for each voting share has been determined
under clause 36(1)(a), that price, which must be certified by the
majority shareholder as meeting the requirements of clause 36(1)(a);
and
(d) If the price to be paid for each voting share is to be fixed by an
arbitrator under clause 36(1)(b), the name of the arbitrator and the
date on which and place at which the arbitration is to be held; and
(e) The rights of minority shareholders under clause 39.
(2) The date referred to in subclause (1)(d) must not be less than 60 working
days from the date on which the notice is given to minority shareholders.

38 Requirements for price for voting share determined under clause 36(1)(a)

If the price to be paid for each voting share has been determined under
clause 36(1)(a), a notice given under clause 35 must also –
(a) Specify a date not less than 20 working days from the date of the
notice on which the price will be paid, and the shares will be
acquired by the majority shareholder (transfer date); and
(b) Advise the shareholder that no payment will be received by the
shareholder until any share certificate that has been issued in respect
of the voting shares has been delivered to the company; and
(c) Require the shareholder to specify the manner in which payment
for the voting shares is to be made to that shareholder; and
(d) Advise shareholders that payment may be made by cheque to be
collected from the company at a specified address, or posted to a
postal address specified by the shareholder, and may provide for
other payment options.

39 Requirements for price for voting share determined under clause 36(1)(b)

(1) If the price to be paid for each voting share is to be determined under
clause 36(1)(b) and, if any minority shareholder considers that the arbitrator is not
suitably qualified to value the shares, or is not independent, the minority
shareholder may give notice to the company within 10 working days requiring
the company to apply to the Court for appointment of another person as arbitrator.
502 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) If a notice under subclause (1) is received, the company must immediately apply to the Court for the appointment of an arbitrator.
(3) If a notice is given under subclause (1), or if for any other reason the arbitration does not proceed on the date and at the place specified in the notice, not less than 40 working days’ notice of the altered date and place must be given to each minority shareholder.
(4) Each minority shareholder is entitled to attend the arbitration and to be heard, in person or by a representative (who may, but need not, be a lawyer or a public accountant).
(5) The arbitrator must expeditiously determine a fair and reasonable price per share for the shares to be acquired.
(6) The price must not include any discount or premium to reflect the size
of the parcels of shares to be acquired, or the circumstances of the acquisition.
(7) The costs of the arbitration must be paid by the majority shareholder.

40 Notice of determination of price by arbitrator

Within 10 working days of the determination by the arbitrator, the company
must give a notice to each minority shareholder that –
(a) Advises the shareholder of the price that has been determined by
the arbitrator; and
(b) Specifies a date not less than 10 working days and not more than 20
working days from the date of the notice on which the price will be
paid, and the shares will be acquired by the majority shareholder
(transfer date); and
(c) Advises the shareholder that no payment will be received by the
shareholder until any share certificate that has been issued in respect
of the voting shares has been delivered to the company; and
(d) Requires the shareholder to specify the manner in which payment
for the voting shares is to be made to that shareholder; and
(e) Advises the shareholders that payment may be made by cheque to
be collected from the company at a specified address, or posted to
a postal address specified by the shareholder, and may provide for
other payment options.

41 Requirements on transfer date

(1) On the transfer date –
(a) The majority shareholder must pay the full amount of the price for
all voting shares held by minority shareholders to the company, to
be held on trust by the company for the benefit of those shareholders.
The payment must be made in cleared funds; and
(b) All voting shares held by minority shareholders are deemed to be
transferred to the majority shareholder on payment to the company
in accordance with paragraph (a), and the company must register
the majority shareholder as the holder of those shares despite any
outstanding share certificates in respect of those shares.
(2) Subject to subclause (5), within 3 working days of the transfer date the
company must pay each minority shareholder the price for that shareholder ’s
voting shares, in the manner specified by that shareholder.
(3) If the shareholder has specified that a cheque will be collected from the
company by that shareholder, the cheque must be held ready for collection from
that date.

Companies Act 2006

503
(4) If the company fails to make a payment, or to make it available for collection, the company must pay interest to the shareholder from the due date to the date on which the payment is made, or is made available for collection, at the rate of 15% per annum, accruing daily and compounding monthly.
(5) If a share certificate has been issued in respect of voting shares held by a minority shareholder, no payment may be made to that minority shareholder until the minority shareholder delivers to the company –
(a) The share certificate; or
(b) Evidence as to its loss or destruction and, if required, an indemnity
in a form determined by the directors.

42 Application of exit rights

Exit rights

(1) Subject to subclause (2), this clause and clauses 43 to 48 apply to a shareholder (acquirer) who –
(a) Acquires shares in the company or otherwise becomes interested in shares in the company (acquisition); and
(b) Before the acquisition, was interested in less than 50% of the voting
shares of the company; and
(c) Following the acquisition, is interested in 50% or more of the voting
shares of the company.
(2) A person may be exempted from the application of this clause and
clauses 43 to 48, either with or without conditions, by a special resolution of holders
of voting shares other than –
(a) Voting shares in which that person is interested; and
(b) Voting shares in which any other person is interested, where that
other person is interested in not less than 50% of the company’s
voting shares.

43 Acquirer to give notice to company

An acquirer must, within 10 working days of first becoming a shareholder
to whom this clause applies, give notice to the company –
(a) Advising the company that the acquirer is a shareholder to whom
this clause applies; and
(b) Identifying the names of the holders of all voting shares in which
the acquirer is interested, and the number of shares held by each of
them in which the acquirer is interested; and
(c) Offering to purchase all voting shares in which the acquirer is not
interested (remaining shares) on the terms set out in clause 44.

44 Consideration for remaining shares

A notice given under clause 43 must be signed by the acquirer or, if the
acquirer is a corporation, by a director of that corporation, and must –
(a) Specify the highest price paid for any voting share in the company
by the acquirer, or by any person holding shares in which the
acquirer is interested, from the date 6 months before the date on
which the acquirer first became a person to whom this clause applies
up to the date of the notice; and
(b) If any shares in which the acquirer is interested were acquired
during this period for a non-cash consideration, describe that
consideration and state an assessment of the cash value to which
that consideration corresponds; and
504 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(c) Specify the consideration offered by the acquirer for each remaining share, which may, but need not, be a cash consideration (consideration); and
(d) Specify the date on which the acquirer will provide the consideration for any remaining shares in respect of which the offer is accepted, which must be not less than 20 working days nor more than 40 working days from the date on which the notice is given to the company (transfer date); and
(e) Specify the rights of the holders of remaining shares under clause
47.

45 Independent report

A notice given under clause 43 must be accompanied by a report from an
independent, appropriately qualified person previously approved by the company,
confirming that the consideration offered is a fair and reasonable consideration
for a share, without any discount or premium to reflect the size of the parcels of
shares to be acquired or the circumstances of the acquisition.

46 Notice to holders of remaining shares

(1) Within 10 working days of receiving a notice under clause 43, the
company must forward the notice to all holders of remaining shares.
(2) The notice under subclause (1) may, but need not, be accompanied by –
(a) Additional information provided by the directors in relation to the
offer;
(b) A recommendation by the directors as to whether or not the offer
should be accepted.
(3) The company must also immediately give public notice of the notice
given to shareholders.

47 Rights of holders of remaining shares

(1) A shareholder to whom a notice is given under clause 46 –
(a) Is not required to accept the offer;
(b) May accept the offer by notice in writing to the company within 20
working days of the date on which the notice was given to the
shareholder.
(2) If a shareholder gives notice accepting an offer in accordance with
subclause (1)(b), there is deemed to be a contract between the acquirer and the
shareholder for the purchase by the acquirer of the remaining shares held by that
shareholder –
(a) On the transfer date; and
(b) For the consideration.

48 When voting rights not to be exercised

(1) If a shareholder to whom this clause applies fails to give the notice
required under clause 43 within the time specified in that clause, no voting rights
may be exercised in respect of any shares in which that acquirer is interested until
that notice has been given.
(2) If a person who is not a shareholder becomes interested in 40% or more
of the voting shares of the company, no voting rights may be exercised in respect
of any voting shares in which that person is interested unless that person –
(a) Is exempted by a special resolution under clause 42(2); or
(b) Undertakes to the company to make an offer as if that person were
an acquirer, and complies with that undertaking.

49 Number of directors

Companies Act 2006

PART 3
DIRECTORS
505
(1) The minimum number of directors is 2. (2) The maximum number of directors is 10.
(3) The shareholders may, by ordinary resolution, vary the minimum or
maximum number of directors of the company.

50 Appointment and removal of directors

A director may be appointed or removed by ordinary resolution passed at
a meeting called for the purpose, or by a written resolution in accordance with
clause 28(1).

51 Term of office

(1) The resolution appointing a director may specify the period for which
the director is to hold office.
(2) On the expiry of any period specified in this manner, the director ceases
to hold office unless reappointed.

52 When director vacates office

A director vacates office if he or she –
(a) Is removed from office in accordance with clause 50; or
(b) Ceases to hold office in accordance with clause 51; or
(c) Resigns in accordance with clause 53; or
(d) Becomes disqualified from being a director under section 85 of the
Act; or
(e) Dies; or
(f) Is absent from 3 consecutive meetings of the directors without leave
being granted by a resolution of the directors, and the directors
resolve that that director has vacated office.

53 Resignation of director

(1) A director may resign by delivering a signed written notice of
resignation to the registered office of the company.
(2) Subject to subclauses (3) and (4), the notice is effective when it is received
at the registered office, or at any later time specified in the notice.
(3) If the company has only 1 director, that director may not resign –
(a) Until that director has called a meeting of shareholders to receive
notice of the resignation; or
(b) If the company has only 1 shareholder, until that director has given
not less than 10 working days’ notice of the resignation to that
shareholder.
(4) A notice of resignation given by the sole director of the company does
not take effect, despite its terms, until the earlier of the appointment of another
director of the company or –
(a) The time and date for which the meeting of shareholders is called
under subclause (3)(a); or
(b) If the company has only 1 shareholder, 10 working days after notice
of the resignation has been given to that shareholder.
506 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

54 Casual vacancies

The directors may appoint any person to be a director to fill a casual vacancy
until the next annual meeting of the company.

55 Notice of changes in directors

(1) The company must ensure that notice in the prescribed form of the
following is delivered to the Registrar –
(a) A change in the directors of the company, whether as the result of a
director ceasing to hold office or the appointment of a new director,
or both;
(b) A change in the name or the residential address of a director of the
company.
(2) In the case of the appointment of a new director, a consent by that person
to act as a director, in the prescribed form, must also be delivered to the Registrar.

56 Powers and duties of directors

(1) Subject to section 50 of the Act (which relates to major transactions) the
business and affairs of the company must be managed by, or under the direction
or supervision of, the directors.
(2) The directors have all the powers necessary for managing, and for
directing and supervising the management of, the business and affairs of the
company.
(3) The directors may delegate any of their powers to a committee of
directors, or to a director or employee.
(4) The directors must monitor, by means of reasonable methods properly
used, the exercise of powers by any delegate.
(5) The provisions of these rules relating to proceedings of the directors
also apply to proceedings of any committee of directors, except to the extent the
directors determine otherwise.
(6) The directors have the duties set out in the Act, and, in particular –
(a) Each director must act in good faith and in a manner that the director
believes to be in the interests of the company; and
(b) A director must not act, or agree to the company acting, in a manner
that contravenes the Act or these rules.

57 Standard of care of directors

A director of the company, when exercising powers or performing duties
as a director, must exercise the care, diligence, and skill that a reasonable person
would exercise in the same circumstances, taking into account, but without
limitation –
(a) The nature of the company; and
(b) The nature of the decision; and
(c) The position of the director and the nature of the responsibilities
undertaken by him or her.

58 Obligations of directors in connection with insolvency

(1) A director of the company must call a meeting of directors within 10
working days to consider whether the directors should appoint an administrator
or liquidator, in accordance with section 71 of the Act, if the director –
(a) Believes that the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall
due; or

Companies Act 2006

507
(b) Is aware of matters that would put any reasonable person on inquiry as to whether the company is unable to pay its debts as they fall due.
(2) At a meeting called under section 71 of the Act the directors must consider whether to appoint an administrator or liquidator, or to continue to carry on the business of the company.

59 Interested directors

(1) A director must not exercise any power as a director in circumstances
where that director is directly or indirectly materially interested in the exercise of
that power unless –
(a) The Act expressly authorises the director to exercise the relevant
power despite such an interest; or
(b) The director has reasonable grounds for believing that the company
will satisfy the solvency test after that power is exercised, and
either –
(i) these rules expressly authorise the director to exercise the
relevant power despite such an interest, and the interest has
been disclosed in accordance with clause 63(4); or
(ii) the matter in question has been approved by shareholders
under section 51 of the Act, following disclosure of the nature
and extent of the director ’s interest to all shareholders who are
not otherwise aware of those matters.
(2) A transaction entered into by the company in which a director is directly
or indirectly materially interested is voidable at the election of the company in
accordance with section 111 of the Act.
(3) A transaction entered into by the company as the result of action taken
by a director in breach of sections 65, 66, or 67 of the Act is voidable at the option
of the company in accordance with section 112 of the Act.

60 Use and disclosure of company information

A director of the company who has information in his or her capacity as a
director or employee of the company, being information that would not otherwise
be available to him or her, must not disclose that information to any person, or
make use of or act on the information, except –
(a) In the interests of the company; or
(b) As required by law; or
(c) If there are reasonable grounds for believing that the company will
satisfy the solvency test after the director takes that action, and that
action –
(i) is approved by all shareholders under section 51 of the Act; or
(ii) is authorised by any contract of employment entered into
between that director and the company, the relevant terms of
which have been disclosed in the interests register referred to
in clause 63.

61 Indemnities and insurance for directors or employees

(1) Subject to section 74 of the Act, the company may provide an indemnity
or purchase insurance for a director of the company or of a related company with
the approval of –
(a) The directors; but no director may vote on a resolution concerning
an indemnity or insurance to be provided for him or her; or
508 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Shareholders by ordinary resolution; but no director may vote on a resolution concerning an indemnity or insurance to be provided for him or her; or
(c) All shareholders under section 51 of the Act. (2) In subclause (1) –
director includes –
(a) A person who is liable under any of sections 65 to 71 of the Act by
virtue of section 73 of the Act; and
(b) A former director
indemnify includes relieve or excuse from liability, whether before or after
the liability arises; and
indemnity has a corresponding meaning.

62 Remuneration of directors

Directors may receive remuneration and other benefits from the company
with the approval of –
(a) The directors; but no director may vote on a resolution concerning
remuneration or other benefits to be provided for him or her; or
(b) Shareholders by ordinary resolution; but no director may vote on a
resolution concerning remuneration or benefits to be received by
him or her; or
(c) All shareholders under section 51 of the Act.

63 Disclosure of interests by directors

(1) The company must –
(a) Maintain an interests register; and
(b) Permit any director or shareholder to inspect the interests register
as if sections 120 and 121 of the Act applied to the interests register.
(2) The annual report of the company under section 56 of the Act in respect
of any accounting period must contain all entries made in the interests register in
the course of that accounting period.
(3) The directors must enter in the interests register details of any –
(a) Contract of employment to which clause 60(c) applies; and
(b) Indemnity or insurance provided for a director under clause 61;
and
(c) Details of any remuneration or other benefits provided to directors
under clause 62; and
(d) Disclosure by a director under subclauses (4) or (5).
(4) A director who is in any way directly or indirectly materially interested
in a transaction or proposed transaction with the company must, within 10 working
days of becoming aware of that interest –
(a) Disclose that interest in writing to the directors; and
(b) Ensure that details of that disclosure are entered in the interests
register.
(5) A director may disclose to the other directors, and enter in the interests
register, a general disclosure that the director is a director or employee or
shareholder of another company, or is otherwise associated with another company
or another person.
(6) Disclosure under subclause (5) is disclosure of the director ’s interest in
any transaction entered into with that other company or person for the purposes
of subclause (4).

Companies Act 2006

509

64 Procedure at meetings of directors

(1) Clauses 65 to 74 set out the procedure to be followed at meetings of
directors.
(2) A meeting of directors may determine its own procedure, to the extent
that it is not governed by these rules.

65 Chairperson

(1) The directors may elect 1 of their number as chairperson of directors
and may determine the period for which the chairperson is to hold office.
(2) If no chairperson is elected, or if at a meeting of the directors the
chairperson is not present within 5 minutes after the time appointed for the
commencement of the meeting, the directors present may choose 1 of their number
to be the chairperson of the meeting.

66 Notice of meeting

(1) A director or, if requested by a director to do so, an employee of the
company, may convene a meeting of directors by giving notice in accordance with
this clause.
(2) Not less than 24 hours’ notice of a meeting of directors must be given
to every director who is in Niue, or who may readily be contacted outside Niue.
(3) An irregularity in the notice of a meeting is waived if all directors
entitled to receive notice of the meeting attend the meeting without protest as to
the irregularity, or if all directors entitled to receive notice of the meeting agree to
the waiver.

67 Methods of holding meetings

A meeting of directors may be held either –
(a) By a number of the directors who constitute a quorum, being
assembled together at the place, date, and time appointed for the
meeting; or
(b) By means of audio, or audio and visual, communication by which
all directors participating and constituting a quorum, may
simultaneously hear each other throughout the meeting.

68 Quorum

(1) A quorum for a meeting of directors is a majority of the directors.
(2) No business may be transacted at a meeting of directors if a quorum is
not present.

69 Voting

(1) Every director has 1 vote.
(2) The chairperson has a casting vote.
(3) A resolution of the directors is passed if it is agreed to by all directors
present without dissent, or if a majority of the votes cast on it are in favour of it.
(4) A director present at a meeting of directors is presumed to have agreed
to, and to have voted in favour of, a resolution of the directors unless he or she
expressly dissents from or votes against the resolution at the meeting.

70 Minutes

The directors must ensure that minutes are kept of all proceedings at
meetings of the directors.
510 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

71 Unanimous resolution

(1) A resolution in writing signed or assented to by all directors is as valid
and effective as if it had been passed at a meeting of the directors duly convened
and held.
(2) Any such resolution may consist of several documents (including fax
or other similar means of communication) in like form, each signed or assented to
by 1 or more directors.
(3) A copy of any such resolution must be entered in the minute book of
the directors’ proceedings.

72 Managing director and other executive directors

(1) The directors may, from time to time, appoint a director as managing
director for such period and on such terms as they think fit.
(2) Subject to the terms of a managing director ’s appointment, the directors
may, at any time, cancel the appointment of a director as managing director.
(3) A director who holds office as managing director ceases to hold office
as managing director if he or she ceases to be a director of the company.

73 Delegation to managing director

(1) The directors may delegate to the managing director, subject to any
conditions or restrictions that they consider appropriate, any of their powers that
may be lawfully delegated.
(2) Any such delegation may at any time be withdrawn or varied by the
directors.
(3) The delegation of a power of the directors to the managing director
does not prevent the exercise of the power by the directors, unless the terms of the
delegation expressly provide otherwise.

74 Remuneration of managing director and executive directors

(1) The managing director may be paid such remuneration as he or she
may agree with the directors.
(2) A director (other than the managing director) who is employed by the
company may be paid such remuneration as may be agreed between that director
and the other directors.
(3) The remuneration referred to in subclauses (1) and (2) may be by way
of salary, commission, participation in profits or any combination of these methods,
or any other method of fixing remuneration.

75 Company records

PART 4
COMPANY RECORDS
(1) The company must keep all the following documents at its registered office or at some other place notice of which has been given to the Registrar in accordance with section 119 of the Act –
(a) The rules of the company;
(b) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of shareholders within the
last 7 years;
(c) Minutes of all meetings and resolutions of directors and directors’
committees within the last 7 years;
(d) The full names and residential and postal addresses of the current
directors;

Companies Act 2006

511
(e) Copies of all written communications to all shareholders or all holders of the same class of shares during the last 7 years, including annual reports made under section 56 of the Act;
(f) Copies of all financial statements required to be completed under section 130 of the Act for the last 7 completed accounting periods of the company;
(g) The accounting records required by section 129 of the Act for the current accounting period and for the last 7 completed accounting periods of the company;
(h) The share register.
(2) The references in subclause (1)(b), (c), and (e) to 7 years and the
references in subclause (1)(f) and (g) to 7 completed accounting periods include
any lesser periods that the Registrar may approve by notice in writing to the
company, in accordance with section 117(2) of the Act.
(3) The interests register required to be kept under clause 63 must be –
(a) Kept at the same place as the written communications to
shareholders referred to in clause 75(1)(e); and
(b) Kept in a form that complies with clause 76; and
(c) Made available to shareholders in the same manner as records to
which clause 76(2) applies.

76 Form of records

(1) The records of the company must be kept –
(a) In written form; or
(b) In a form or in a manner that allows the documents and information
that comprise the records to be readily accessible so as to be usable
for subsequent reference, and convertible into written form.
(2) The directors must ensure that adequate measures exist to –
(a) Prevent the records being falsified; and
(b) Detect any falsification of them.

77 Access to records

(1) The directors of the company are entitled to access to the company’s
records in accordance with section 120 of the Act.
(2) A shareholder of the company is entitled –
(a) To inspect the documents referred to in section 121 of the Act, in
the manner specified in section 123 of the Act; and
(b) To require copies of or extracts from any document that he or she
may inspect within 5 working days of making a request in writing
for the copy or extract, on payment of any reasonable copying and
administration fee prescribed by the company.
(3) The fee may be determined by any director, subject to any directions
from the directors.

78 Documents to be sent to Registrar

In addition to the annual return required under section 124 of the Act, the
company must send all the following documents to the Registrar under the Act –
(a) Notice of the adoption of new rules by the company, or the alteration
of the rules of the company, under section 14;
(b) Notice of a change in the registered office of the company, under
section 17 of the Act;
(c) Notice of the issue of shares by the company, under section 26 of
the Act;
512 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) Notice of the acquisition by the company of its own shares, under section 31 of the Act;
(e) Notice of the redemption of a share, under section 35 of the Act;
(f) Notice of a change in the directors of the company, or of a change
in the name or residential address or postal address of a director,
under section 88 of the Act;
(g) Notice of the making of an order under section 103 of the Act altering
or adding to the rules of a company;
(h) Notice of any place other than the registered office of the company
where records are kept, or of any change in the place where records
are kept, under section 119 of the Act;
(i) Documents requested by the Registrar under the Act.

79 Documents to be sent to shareholders

In addition to the annual report required under section 56 of the Act, the
company must send all the following documents to shareholders under the Act –
(a) Notice of any repurchase of shares to which section 31(4) of the Act
applies;
(b) Notice of a written resolution approved under section 53 of the
Act;
(c) Financial statements required to be sent under section 130 of the
Act;
(d) Any written statement by an auditor under section 136 of the Act
(e) The report by the auditor under section 138 of the Act.
PART 5
ACCOUNTS AND AUDIT

80 Accounting records to be kept

(1) The directors of the company must cause accounting records to be kept
that –
(a) Correctly record and explain the transactions of the company; and
(b) Will at any time enable the financial position of the company to be
determined with reasonable accuracy; and
(c) Will enable the directors to ensure that the financial statements of
the company comply with section 130 of the Act; and
(d) Will enable the financial statements of the company to be readily
and properly audited.
(2) Without limiting subclause (1), the accounting records must contain –
(a) Entries of money received and spent each day and the matters to
which it relates; and
(b) A record of the assets and liabilities of the company; and
(c) If the company’s business involves dealing in goods –
(i) a record of goods bought and sold, and relevant invoices; and
(ii) a record of stock held at the end of the financial year together
with records of any stocktakings during the year; and
(d) If the company’s business involves providing services, a record of
services provided and relevant invoices.
(3) If the company sells goods or provides services for cash in the ordinary
course of carrying on a retail business –
(a) Invoices need not be kept in respect of each retail transaction for
the purposes of subclause (2); and

Companies Act 2006

513
(b) A record of the total money received each day in respect of the sale of goods or provision of services, as the case may be, is sufficient to comply with subclause (2) in respect of those transactions.
(4) The accounting records must be kept –
(a) In a form permitted under clause 76; and
(b) At the registered office of the company, or any other place permitted
under section 119 of the Act.

81 Financial statements to be prepared

(1) The directors must ensure that –
(a) Within 4 months after the balance date of the company, financial
statements that comply with subclause (2) are completed in relation
to the company and that balance date; and
(b) Within 20 working days of the date on which the financial
statements must be completed under paragraph (a), those financial
statements are sent to all shareholders. This requirement may be
satisfied by sending the financial statements to shareholders in an
annual report, in accordance with section 56 of the Act.
(2) The financial statements of the company must –
(a) Give a true and fair view of the matters to which they relate; and
(b) Comply with any applicable regulations made under the Act; and
(c) Be dated and signed on behalf of the directors by 2 directors of the
company, or, if the company has only 1 director, by that director.
(3) The period between –
(a) The date of incorporation of the company and its first balance date;
or
(b) Any 2 balance dates of the company –
must not exceed 15 months.
(4) In this clause, financial statements, in relation to the company and a
balance date, means –
(a) A statement of financial position for the entity as at the balance
date; and
(b) In the case of –
(i) A company trading for profit, a statement of financial
performance for the company in relation to the accounting
period ending at the balance date; and
(ii) A company not trading for profit, an income and expenditure
statement for the company in relation to the accounting period
ending at the balance date; and
(c) If required by regulations made under the Act, a statement of cash
flows for the company in relation to the accounting period ending
on the balance date; and
(d) Such other financial statements in relation to the company or any
group of companies of which it is the holding company as may be
required by regulations made under the Act; and
(e) Any notes or documents giving information relating to the
statement of financial position and other statements.

82 Appointment of auditor

(1) The company must appoint an auditor who is qualified to hold that
office under section 135 of the Act to –
514 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) Audit the financial statements of the company in respect of an accounting period; and
(b) Hold office until those financial statements have been audited in accordance with the Act or until he or she ceases to hold office.
(2) The company must appoint an auditor within 30 working days in the event of a vacancy in the office of auditor.
(3) An auditor ceases to hold office if he or she –
(a) Resigns by delivering a written notice of resignation to the registered
office of the company not less than 20 working days before the date
on which the notice is expressed to be effective; or
(b) Is replaced as auditor by an ordinary resolution appointing another
person as auditor in his or her place, following notice to the auditor
in accordance with section 133 of the Act; or
(c) Becomes disqualified from being the auditor of the company; or
(d) Becomes subject to a trustee order under section 501 of the Niue
Act 1966, or an order of medical custody under section 602 of that
Act; or
(e) Dies.
(4) An auditor may be appointed –
(a) By ordinary resolution; or
(b) If the office of auditor is vacant, by the directors. If an auditor is
appointed by the directors, the directors must, within 10 working
days, give notice of the appointment to all shareholders.
(5) The fees payable to the auditor must be agreed between the auditor
and the directors.

83 Auditor’s attendance at shareholders’ meeting

The directors must ensure that an auditor of the company –
(a) Is permitted to attend a meeting of shareholders of the company;
and
(b) Receives the notices and communications that a shareholder is
entitled to receive relating to meetings or resolutions of
shareholders; and
(c) May be heard at a meeting of shareholders that he or she attends
on any part of the business of the meeting that concerns him or her
as auditor.
PART 6
LIQUIDATION AND REMOVAL FROM REGISTER

84 Resolution to appoint liquidator

(1) The shareholders may resolve to liquidate the company by special
resolution.
(2) The directors may resolve to liquidate the company at a meeting called
under section 71 of the Act, if they consider that the company is unable to meet its
debts as they become due in the normal course of business.

85 Distribution of surplus assets

(1) The surplus assets of the company available for distribution to
shareholders after all creditors of the company have been paid must be distributed
in proportion to the number of shares held by each shareholder, subject to the
terms of issue of any shares.

Companies Act 2006

515
(2) The liquidator may, with the approval of a special resolution, distribute the surplus assets of the company among the shareholders in kind.
(3) For the purposes of subclause (2), the liquidator may –
(a) Set such value as he or she considers fair on any property to be
divided; and
(b) Determine how the division will be carried out as between the
shareholders or different classes of shareholders.
PART 7
MISCELLANEOUS

86 Service of documents on shareholders

(1) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder who is a natural person may be –
(a) Delivered to that person; or
(b) Posted to that person’s postal address; or
(c) Faxed to a fax number used by that person for the transmission of
documents.
(2) A notice, statement, report, accounts, or other document to be sent to a
shareholder that is a company or an overseas company may be sent by any of the
methods of serving documents referred to in section 342 or section 344 of the Act,
as the case may be.

87 Interpretation

(1) In these rules, Act means the Companies Act 2005.
(2) Unless the context otherwise requires, any term or expression that is
defined in the Act or any regulations made under the Act and used, but not defined,
in these rules has the same meaning as in the Act or the regulations.
(3) For the purposes of these rules –
(a) Voting share means a share that confers on its holder the right to
vote on a resolution to amend the rules;
(b) The percentage of voting shares held by any person is treated as
equal to the percentage of votes that that person is entitled to cast
on such a resolution.
(4) For the purposes of these rules, a person is interested in a voting share
if that person –
(a) Is a beneficial owner of the share; or
(b) Has the power to exercise any right to vote attached to the share; or
(c) Has the power to control the exercise of any right to vote attached
to the share; or
(d) Has the power to acquire or dispose of the share; or
(e) Has the power to control the acquisition or disposition of the share
by another person; or
(f) Under, or by virtue of, any trust, agreement, arrangement or
understanding relating to the share (whether or not that person is a
party to it, and whether or not it is legally enforceable) may, at any
time, have the power to –
(i) exercise any right to vote attached to the share; or
(ii) control the exercise of any right to vote attached to the share;
or
(iii) acquire or dispose of, the share; or
(iv) control the acquisition or disposition of the share by another
person.
516 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(5) A person who has, or may have, a power referred to in subclause (4)(b)
to (f) is interested in a share, regardless of whether the power is –
(a) Express or implied;
(b) Direct or indirect;
(c) Legally enforceable or not;
(d) Related to a particular share or not;
(e) Subject to restraint or restriction or is capable of being made subject
to restraint or restriction;
(f) Exercisable presently or in the future;
(g) Exercisable only on the fulfilment of a condition;
(h) Exercisable alone or jointly with another person or persons.
–––––––––––––––––––––
SCHEDULE 5
MINORITY BUY-OUT PROCEDURE
s 55

1

Shareholder may give notice requiring

4

Objection to share price

purchase of shares

5

Nominated price payable if no objection

2

Directors’ duties on receipt of notice

6

Expert determination of price

requiring purchase

7

Purchase of shares by third party

3

Directors to nominate and give notice of

8

Inability of company to pay purchase price

price for shares

1 Shareholder may give notice requiring purchase of shares

A shareholder of a company who is entitled to require the company to
purchase shares by virtue of section 55 may –
(a) Within 10 working days of the passing of the resolution at a meeting
of shareholders; or
(b) If the resolution was passed under section 53, within 10 working
days of the date on which notice of the passing of the resolution is
given to the shareholder –
give a written notice to the company requiring the company to purchase those
shares

2 Directors’ duties on receipt of notice requiring purchase

Within 20 working days of receiving a notice under clause 1, the directors
must –
(a) Agree to the purchase of the shares by the company; or
(b) Arrange for some other person to agree to purchase the shares; or
(c) Arrange, before taking the action concerned, for the resolution to
be rescinded or decide in the appropriate manner not to take the
action concerned, as the case may be; and
(d) Give written notice to the shareholder of the directors’ decision.

3 Directors to nominate and give notice of price for shares

(1) If the directors agree under clause 2(a) to the purchase of the shares by
the company, the directors must, on giving notice under that clause or within 5
working days after giving that notice –

Companies Act 2006

517
(a) Nominate a date on which the shares will be acquired by the company (purchase date), which must not be less than 10 working days or more than 20 working days from the date of giving notice to the shareholder; and
(b) Nominate a fair and reasonable price for the shares to be acquired;
and
(c) Give notice of the price to the holder of those shares.
(2) On the purchase date –
(a) The shares are deemed to be transferred to the company; and
(b) The company is liable to pay for the shares in accordance with this
clause, subject to section 28.
(3) For the purposes of this schedule, a price for a share is a fair and
reasonable price if it is a fair and reasonable price for a share in the company as at
the purchase date, disregarding –
(a) Any premium or discount in respect of the size of parcels of shares
to be acquired;
(b) The fact that the shares are being acquired under section 55;
(c) The effect or likely effect on the value of the company and its shares
of the company approving the resolution, the approval of which
entitled the shareholder to require the company to purchase his or
her shares.

4 Objection to share price

(1) A shareholder who considers that the price nominated by the directors
is not fair or reasonable must, within 10 working days, give notice of objection to
the company.
(2) If, within 10 working days of giving notice to a shareholder under clause
3(1), an objection to the price has been received by the company, the company
must –
(a) Refer the question of what is a fair and reasonable price to determination by an expert in accordance with clause 6; and
(b) On the purchase date, pay a provisional price in respect of each
share equal to the price nominated by the directors.

5 Nominated price payable if no objection

If, within 10 working days of giving notice to a shareholder under clause
3(1), no objection to the price has been received by the company, the price to be
paid for the shares is the nominated price.

6 Expert determination of price

(1) If the company is required to refer the price for shares to expert
determination in accordance with clause 4(2)(a), the company must, within 10
working days, nominate an independent person with appropriate expertise as
the expert to determine the price, and give notice of that appointment to the
shareholder.
(2) The shareholder may, within 10 working days of receiving the notice
referred to in subclause (1), give notice to the company that he or she objects to the
expert nominated by the company, on the grounds that that person –
(a) Is not independent; or
(b) Does not have the appropriate expertise.
(3) If, within 10 working days of receipt of notice by a shareholder under
subclause (1), no objection to the expert has been received by the company, the
518 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
expert must expeditiously determine a fair and reasonable price for the shares to be purchased.
(4) If, within 10 working days of receipt of notice by a shareholder under subclause (1), an objection to the expert has been received by the company, the company must immediately apply to the Court for the appointment of an expert. The Court may appoint the person nominated by the company, or any person nominated by the shareholder, or such other independent person with appropriate expertise as the Court may think fit. The expert appointed by the Court must, immediately on being appointed, proceed to expeditiously determine a fair and reasonable price for the shares to be purchased.
(5) If the price determined by the expert –
(a) Exceeds the provisional price, the company must, subject to section
28, immediately pay the balance owing to the shareholder;
(b) Is less than the provisional price paid, the company may recover
the excess paid from the shareholder.
(6) The expert may award interest on any balance payable or excess to be
repaid under subclause (5) at such rate as he or she thinks fit.
(7) The determination by the expert is final and is made by the expert as
an expert, and not as an arbitrator.

7 Purchase of shares by third party

(1) Clauses 3 to 6 apply to the purchase of shares by a person with whom
the company has entered into an arrangement for purchase in accordance with
clause 2(b), subject to such modifications as may be necessary and, in particular,
as if references in that section to the directors and the company were references to
that person.
(2) Every holder of shares that are to be purchased in accordance with the
arrangement is indemnified by the company in respect of loss suffered by reason
of the failure by the person who has agreed to purchase the shares to purchase
them at the price nominated or fixed by arbitration, as the case may be.

8 Inability of company to pay purchase price

Section 33 applies to the purchase of shares under this schedule as if there
were a contract between the shareholder and the company for the purchase of
shares in accordance with this schedule.
––––––––––––––––––––––
SCHEDULE 6
AMALGAMATIONS
s 144

1

Approval of amalgamation proposal

3

Process for approving amalgamation

2

Contents of amalgamation proposal

proposal

4

Short form amalgamation

1 Approval of amalgamation proposal

(1) Subject to subclause (2), an amalgamation proposal must be approved
in accordance with clause 3 and the rules of each amalgamating company. (2) An amalgamation proposal that relates to the amalgamation –
(a) Of a company with 1 or more other companies that is or that are

Companies Act 2006

519
directly or indirectly wholly owned by it; or
(b) Of 2 or more companies each of which is directly or indirectly wholly
owned by the same person –
may be approved in accordance with clause 4.

2 Contents of amalgamation proposal

(1) An amalgamation proposal must set out the terms of the amalgamation
and, in particular –
(a) The name of the amalgamated company, which may be the name
of 1 of the amalgamating companies, or a new name that complies
with section 10; and
(b) Whether the amalgamated company is a private company or a
public company; and
(c) The full name and residential address and postal address of every
proposed director of the amalgamated company; and
(d) The registered office of the amalgamated company; and
(e) The postal address of the company, which may be either the postal
address of the registered office or any other postal address; and
(f) The manner in which the shares of each amalgamating company
are to be converted into shares of the amalgamated company; and
(g) If shares of an amalgamating company are not to be converted into
shares of the amalgamated company, the consideration that the
holders of those shares are to receive instead of shares of the
amalgamated company; and
(h) Any payment to be made to a shareholder or director of an
amalgamating company, other than a payment of the kind described
in paragraph (g); and
(i) Details of any arrangement necessary to complete the amalgamation
and to provide for the subsequent management and operation of
the amalgamated company.
(2) The amalgamation proposal must –
(a) Specify whether the rules of the amalgamated company will be the
model rules in Schedules 2, 3, or 4; or
(b) Include a copy of the rules of the amalgamated company, if they
differ from the model rules.
(3) An amalgamation proposal may specify the date on which the
amalgamation is intended to become effective.
(4) If shares of 1 of the amalgamating companies are held by or on behalf
of another of the amalgamating companies, the amalgamation proposal –
(a) Must provide for the cancellation of those shares without payment
or the provision of other consideration when the amalgamation
becomes effective; and
(b) Must not provide for the conversion of those shares into shares of
the amalgamated company.

3 Process for approving amalgamation proposal

(1) The directors of each amalgamating company must send to each
shareholder of the company, not less than 20 working days before the
amalgamation is proposed to take effect –
(a) A copy of the amalgamation proposal; and
(b) A statement setting out the rights of shareholders under section
148; and
520

4

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

(c) A statement of any material interests of the directors in the proposal, whether in that capacity or otherwise; and
(d) Any further information and explanation that may be necessary to enable a reasonable shareholder to understand the nature and implications for the company and its shareholders of the proposed amalgamation.
(2) The amalgamation proposal must be approved –
(a) By the shareholders of each amalgamating company by special
resolution, as if the proposal were a proposal to alter the rules of
the company; and
(b) If a provision in the amalgamation proposal would, if contained in
an amendment to an amalgamating company’s rules or otherwise
proposed in relation to that company, require the approval of an
interest group, by –
(i) a special resolution of each interest group; or
(ii) all shareholders under section 51.

Short form amalgamation

(1) An amalgamation proposal in relation to a company (parent company)
and 1 or more other companies that is or that are directly or indirectly wholly owned by it may be approved by a resolution of the directors of each amalgamating company, if the amalgamation proposal provides that –
(a) The shares of each amalgamating company, other than the parent company, will be cancelled without payment or other consideration; and
(b) The rules of the amalgamated company will be the same as the rules of the parent company.
(2) An amalgamation proposal in relation to 2 or more companies, each of which is directly or indirectly wholly owned by the same person, may be approved by a resolution of the directors of each amalgamating company, if the amalgamation proposal provides that –
(a) The shares of all but 1 of the amalgamating companies will be
cancelled without payment or other consideration; and
(b) The rules of the amalgamated company will be the same as the
rules of the amalgamating company whose shares are not cancelled.
–––––––––––––––––––
SCHEDULE 7
COMPANY CHARGES
s 141

Registration

6

Registrable documents

7

Who may apply for registration

8

Time for submitting registrable documents

9

What must accompany copy of registrable

Rejection of non-complying document

10

Registrar may reject non-complying

document

11

Consequences of rejecting non-complying

document

Companies Act 2006

521

Registration of document

16

Prescribed time for submitting notices

12

When document is registered

17

Matters on which notices may be deferred

13

Certificate of registration

18

Registrar must enter memorandum of

14

No presumption of validity

satisfaction in register

19

Court may order entry of memorandum in

Satisfaction of company charge, etc register

15 Entries of satisfaction and release of

property from registered charge

PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1 Meaning of registrable charge

In this Act, registrable charge means –
(a) A charge for the purpose of securing an issue of debentures;
(b) In the case of an existing company, a charge on uncalled share capital
of the company;
(c) A charge created or evidenced by a document that, if executed by
an individual, would require registration under the Chattels
Transfer Act 1975;
(d) A charge on any motor vehicle of the company;
(e) A floating charge on any property of the company;
(f) A charge on book debts of the company;
(g) A charge on amounts payable on issued shares of the company, but
not paid;
(h) A charge on a ship or any share in a ship;
(i) A charge on any aircraft;
(j) A charge on goodwill, on a patent or a licence under a patent, on a
trade mark or a licence under a trade mark, or on a copyright or a
licence under a copyright.

2 Charges that are not registrable charges

(1) Despite clause 1, the following are not registrable charges for the
purposes of this schedule –
(a) A charge under a charging order issued by a Court in favour of a
judgment creditor;
(b) If a negotiable instrument has been given to secure the payment of
any book debts of a company, the deposit of the negotiable
instrument for the purposes of securing an advance to the company;
(c) A charge in so far as it relates to land or other real property.
(2) Where a charge relates to land or other real property and to other
property, it may be registered despite subclause (1)(c). Such a charge is treated for
the purposes of this schedule as if it related solely to that other property.

3 Constructive notice of registered documents

Registration of a document under this Act –
(a) Constitutes notice to all persons of the details of the document
entered in the register; but
(b) Does not in itself constitute notice to any person of the contents of
the document.
522 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Rectification of register and extension of time

4 Court orders

(1) The Court may, on the application of the company or any interested
person, order that the omission or misstatement of any information registered
under this schedule be rectified.
(2) An order may be made on any conditions that the Court thinks fit.

5 Grounds for Court orders

The Court may make an order under clause 4 only if the Court is satisfied
that –
(a) The omission or misstatement of anything registered under this schedule was accidental, due to misadventure or some other sufficient cause, or was not of a nature to prejudice the position of creditors or shareholders of the company; or
(b) On other grounds, it is just and equitable to grant relief.

6 Registrable documents

Registration

The following documents may be registered under this Act –
(a) A copy of a charge document executed by the company;
(b) In the case of a series of debentures for which there is no charge
document, a copy of 1 of the debentures of the series;
(c) A copy of a charge document over property acquired by the
company that would, if the charge had been created by the company,
have been capable of being registered under this Act;
(d) A copy of an alteration document executed by the company;
(e) A copy of a document assigning the benefit of a company charge;
(f) A copy of a priority document.

7 Who may apply for registration

(1) The following persons may submit a registrable document for
registration –
(a) In the case of an assignment document, the assignee;
(b) In the case of a priority document, a party to that document;
(c) In all cases, the company or any other interested person.
(2) An interested person is entitled to recover from the following persons
the amount of any fees paid by that person to the Registrar for the registration of
the registrable document –
(a) In the case of an assignment of charge, the assignee;
(b) In all cases, the company.

8 Time for submitting registrable documents

A copy of a registrable document may be submitted to the Registrar at any
time.

9 What must accompany copy of registrable document

Every copy of a registrable document must be accompanied by –
(a) The applicable certificate of execution in the prescribed form (if
any); and
(b) The prescribed fee (if any).

Companies Act 2006

523

Rejection of non-complying document

10 Registrar may reject non-complying document

The Registrar may reject a document that is submitted for registration if
it –
(a) Does not comply with this Act;
(b) Is not in a form that may be entered in the register.

11 Consequences of rejecting non-complying document

(1) If the Registrar rejects a document, the Registrar must inform the person
who submitted the document of the Registrar ’s reasons for rejecting the document,
and request the person to –
(a) Amend the rejected document so that it complies with this Act and
submit the amended document to the Registrar within the time
allowed by the Registrar; or
(b) Submit to the Registrar a new document in its place that complies
with this Act within the time allowed by the Registrar.
(2) If the person submits to the Registrar an amended or new document,
this schedule, with the necessary modifications, applies to the document.
(3) If the person does nothing, the rejected document must be treated as if
it had never been submitted to the Registrar for registration.

Registration of document

12 When document is registered

(1) A document or information is registered when the document or
information is entered in the register.
(2) The Registrar may –
(a) Accept as correct the information in any certificate submitted to
the Registrar for the purposes of this Schedule; and
(b) Enter the certified information in the register.

13 Certificate of registration

(1) The Registrar must give a certificate of the registration (certificate of
registration) of any document that is registered under this Act.
(2) A certificate of registration is conclusive evidence that the registration
requirements in this Act have been met.

14 No presumption of validity

Neither registration, nor the rejection, of a document by the Registrar under
this schedule affects, or creates a presumption about, the validity of the document
or the correctness of the information contained in it.

15

and –

Satisfaction of company charge, etc

Entries of satisfaction and release of property from registered charge

(1) A company must submit to the Registrar the prescribed fee (if any)
(a) A notice in the prescribed form (if any) signed by the secured party of any of the applicable matters specified in subclause (2); or
(b) A notice in any other form approved by the Registrar of any of those applicable matters; or
(c) Provide any other evidence to the satisfaction of the Registrar of any of those applicable matters.
524 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) The matters referred to in subclause (1) are that –
(a) The registered charge has been satisfied in whole or part; or
(b) The secured property has been released; or
(c) The secured property has been disposed of subject to the registered
charge.

16 Prescribed time for submitting notices

A notice or evidence to which clause 15 applies must be submitted to the
Registrar within 20 working days after –
(a) The debt for which the registered charge was given has been paid
or satisfied in whole or in part; or
(b) All or any part of the secured property has been released from the
registered charge; or
(c) All or any part of the secured property has been disposed of subject
to the registered charge.

17 Matters on which notice may be deferred

Until a final discharge is signed by the secured party, the company need
not submit to the Registrar a notice or evidence to which clause 15 applies on the
occurrence of –
(a) Any sum being paid to the secured party; or
(b) Any account between the company and the secured party being in
credit.

18 Registrar must enter memorandum of satisfaction in register

On receipt of a notice or other evidence to which clause 19 applies and on
payment of the prescribed fee (if any), the Registrar must enter in the register –
(a) A memorandum of the full or partial satisfaction of the registered
charge;
(b) A memorandum of the fact that all or any part of the secured
property has been released from the registered charge; or
(c) A memorandum of the fact that all or any part of the secured
property has ceased to belong to the company.

19 Court may order entry of memorandum in register

(1) The Court may order that a memorandum under clause 18 be entered
in the register.
(2) If the Court makes an order under subclause (1), the Registrar must
enter the memorandum in the register.
–––––––––––––––––––––

Companies Act 2006

SCHEDULE 8
POWERS, FUNCTIONS, AND LIABILITIES OF ADMINISTRATORS

PART 1

PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1 Administrator is company’s agent

2 Administrator has qualified privilege

3 Administrator may seek directions

4 Exercise of powers, etc, by 2 or more

administrators

5 Exercise of powers, etc, by 2 or more

administrators under compromise

PART 2

POWERS AND FUNCTIONS OF ADMINISTRATORS

6 General powers of administrator

7 Limitations on administrator ’s powers

8 Dealing with property subject to floating

charge that has become fixed charge

9 When administrator may dispose of

encumbered property

PART 3

GENERAL LIABILITY

10 Administrator not liable in damages for

refusing consent

525
s 156
PART 1
PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1 Administrator is company’s agent

When exercising a power, or performing a function, as administrator of a
company, the administrator is taken to be acting as the company’s agent.

2 Administrator has qualified privilege

A person who is, or has been, the administrator of a company has qualified
privilege in respect of a statement that he or she has made, whether orally or in
writing, in the course of exercising his or her powers, or performing his or her
functions, as administrator of the company.

3 Administrator may seek directions

(1) The administrator of a company, or any person who chairs a meeting
of creditors held under subpart 1 of Part 9, may apply to the Court for directions
about a matter arising in connection with the exercise of his or her powers or the
performance of his or her functions.
(2) The administrator under a compromise approved under subpart 1 of
Part 9 may apply to the Court for directions about a matter arising in connection
with the operation of, or giving effect to, the compromise.

4 Exercise of powers, etc, by 2 or more administrators

(1) If subpart 1 of Part 9 provides for an administrator of a company to be
appointed, 2 or more persons may be appointed as administrators of the company.
526 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(2) If there are 2 or more administrators of a company –
(a) A function or power of an administrator of the company may be
performed or exercised by any 1 of them, or by any 2 or more of
them together, except so far as the document or resolution
appointing them otherwise provides; and
(b) A reference in this Act to an administrator, or to the administrator,
of a company is a reference to whichever 1 or more of those
administrators the case requires.

5 Exercise of powers, etc, by 2 or more administrators under compromise

If there are 2 or more administrators of a compromise approved under
subpart 1 of Part 9 –
(a) A function or power of an administrator under the compromise
may be performed or exercised by any 1 of them, or by any 2 or
more of them together, except so far as the document or resolution
appointing them otherwise provides; and
(b) A reference in this Act to an administrator under a compromise is a
reference to whichever 1 or more of those administrators the case
requires.
PART 2
POWERS AND FUNCTIONS OF ADMINISTRATORS

6 General powers of administrator

While a company is under administration, the administrator has control of
the company’s business, property, and affairs and may –
(a) Carry on the company’s business;
(b) Manage the company’s property and affairs;
(c) Terminate or dispose of all or any part of the company’s business;
(d) Dispose of all or any part of the company’s property;
(e) Exercise any power, and perform any function, that the company
or any of its officers could perform or exercise if the company were
not under administration;
(f) With leave of the Court, remove from office a director of the
company;
(g) With leave of the Court, appoint a person as a director of the
company, whether to fill a vacancy or not;
(h) Execute a document, bring or defend proceedings, or do anything
else, in the company’s name and on its behalf;
(i) Do whatever else is necessary for the purposes of subpart 1 of Part
9.

7 Limitations on administrator’s powers

(1) If clause 23 of Schedule 10 applies, the administrator ’s powers and
functions are subject to the powers and functions of –
(a) The secured creditor; or
(b) A receiver or person of a kind referred to in clause 23 of Schedule
10 (even if appointed after the decision period).
(2) If clause 19 of Schedule 10 applies, then, so far as concerns perishable
property of the company, the administrator ’s powers and functions are subject to
the powers and functions of –
(a) The secured creditor; or
(b) A receiver or person appointed (at any time) as mentioned in
paragraphs (a), (b), or (d) of the definition of

Companies Act 2006

527
enforce in clause 1 of Schedule 1.
(3) If clauses 14, 15, or 20 of Schedule 10 apply, then, so far as concerns the
property referred to in those clauses, the administrator ’s powers and functions
are subject to the powers and functions of the secured creditor, receiver, or other
person.

8 Dealing with property subject to floating charge that has become fixed charge

If a floating charge over property of a company has become a fixed charge, then, subject to this schedule, the administrator may deal with any of that property as if the charge were still a floating charge.

9 When administrator may dispose of encumbered property

(1) The administrator of a company must not dispose of –
(a) Property of the company that is subject to a charge; or
(b) Property that is used or occupied by, or is in the possession of, the
company but of which someone else is the owner or lessor.
(2) Subclause (1) does not prevent a disposal –
(a) In the ordinary course of the company’s business if it is authorised
by the terms of the relevant charge, agreement authorising use or
possession, lease or without agreement of the secured creditor,
owner, or lessor; or
(b) With the written consent of the secured creditor, owner, or lessor,
as the case may be; or
(c) With the leave of the Court.
(3) The Court may give leave under subclause (2)(c) only if it is satisfied
that arrangements have been made to protect adequately the interests of the secured
creditor, owner, or lessor, as the case may be.
PART 3
LIABILITY OF ADMINISTRATORS

General liability

10 Administrator not liable in damages for refusing consent

A company’s administrator is not liable to an action or other proceeding
for damages for refusing to give an approval or consent under subpart 1 of Part 9.

11 Liability of administrator for company’s debts

Except as expressly provided in subpart 1 of Part 9 or in this schedule, the
administrator of a company is not liable for the company’s debts.

12 Liability of administrator for debts incurred by administrator

(1) The administrator of a company is liable for the debts that the
administrator incurs in the exercise of his or her powers, or performance of his or
her functions, as administrator for –
(a) Services rendered;
(b) Goods bought;
(c) Property hired, leased, used, or occupied.
(2) Subclause (1) has effect despite any agreement to the contrary, but
without prejudice to the administrator ’s rights against the company or anyone
else.
528 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Liability for rent, etc

13 Application of clauses 14 to 17

Clauses 14 to 17 apply if, under an agreement made before the
administration of a company began, the company continues to use or occupy, or
to be in possession of, property of which someone else is the owner or lessor.

14 Liability of administrator for rent

(1) Subject to this clause, the administrator is liable for that part of the rent
or other amounts payable by the company under the agreement referred to in
clause 13 for any period –
(a) That begins more than 10 working days after the administration
began; and
(b) Throughout which –
(i) the company continues to use or occupy, or to be in possession
of, the property; and
(ii) the administration continues.
(2) Subclause (1) does not apply to so much of a period that elapses after –
(a) A receiver of the property is appointed; or
(b) A secured creditor appoints an agent, under the provisions of a
charge on the property, to enter into possession, or to assume control,
of the property; or
(c) a secured creditor takes possession, or assumes control, of the
property under the provisions of a charge on the property.
(3) Subclause (1) does not apply in so far as a Court, by order, excuses the
administrator from liability.
(4) Subclauses (2) and (3) do not affect the liability of the company.
(5) The administrator is not taken, because of subclause (1) –
(a) To have adopted the agreement; or
(b) To be liable under the agreement otherwise than as mentioned in
subclause (1).

15 Notice stating company does not propose to exercise rights over property

Within 10 working days after the beginning of the administration, the
administrator may give to the owner or lessor a notice that –
(a) specifies the property; and
(b) States that the company does not propose to exercise rights in
relation to the property.

16 Effect of notice

Despite clause 14, the administrator is not liable for so much of the rent or
other amounts payable by the company under the agreement that is attributable
to a period during which a notice under clause 15 is in force, but such a notice
does not affect a liability of the company.

17 When notice ceases to have effect

(1) A notice under clause 15 ceases to have effect if –
(a) The administrator revokes it in writing given to the owner or lessor;
or
(b) The company exercises, or appears to exercise, a right in relation to
the property.

Companies Act 2006

529
(2) For the purposes of subclause (1), the company does not exercise, or appear to exercise, a right in relation to the property merely because the company continues to occupy, or to be in possession of, the property, unless the company –
(a) Also uses the property; or
(b) Asserts a right, as against the owner or lessor, so to continue.

Indemnity

18 Administrator is entitled to indemnity

(1) The administrator of a company is entitled to be indemnified out of the
company’s property for –
(a) The debts for which the administrator is liable under this Act; and
(b) The costs incurred in relation to holding a meeting of creditors under
subpart 1 of Part 9; and
(c) His or her remuneration.
(2) To secure the administrator ’s indemnity, the administrator has a lien
on the company’s property.
(3) An administrator ’s lien has priority over a charge to the extent that the
indemnity has priority over debts secured by the charge.

19 Administrator’s indemnity has priority over unsecured debts, etc

Subject to claims having preference under Part 3 of Schedule 18, an
administrator ’s indemnity has priority over –
(a) All the company’s unsecured debts; and
(b) Subject to clauses 20 and 21, debts of the company secured by a
floating charge on property of the company.

20 Exception for debts secured by floating charge

An administrator ’s indemnity does not have priority over debts secured
by a floating charge if –
(a) Before the beginning of the administration, the secured party –
(i) appointed a receiver of property of the company under a power
contained in the floating charge document concerned; or
(ii) obtained an order for the appointment of a receiver of property
of the company for the purpose of enforcing the charge; or
(iii) Entered into possession, or assumed control, of property of the
company for the purpose of enforcing the charge; or
(iv) appointed a person so to enter into possession or assume control
(whether as agent for the secured creditor or for the company);
and
(b) The receiver or person is still in office, or the secured party is still in
possession or control of the property.

21 Extent of administrator’s indemnity when floating charge has priority

The extent to which a floating charge has priority over an administrator ’s
indemnity is limited to debts incurred, or remuneration accruing, after the secured
party gave written notice to the administrator of the matter specified in clause
20(a) that gave the secured party priority over the indemnity.
530 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
SCHEDULE 9
OFFICE OF ADMINISTRATOR
s 158(1)(a)

Restrictions on appointment of administrators

6

Replacement administrator to hold

1

Who may not be appointed or act as

creditors’ meeting

administrator

7

Court order if vacancy in office

2

Validity of acts of administrators

ofadministrator

3

Person must consent to being appointed

8

Vacancy in office of administrator under

administrator

compromise

4

Court may declare whether administrator

validly appointed Administrators’ remuneration

9 Remuneration of administrator

Vacancy in office of administrator

5 Vacancy in office of administrator

Restrictions on appointment of administrators

1 Who may not be appointed or act as administrator

None of the following may be appointed or act as an administrator of a
company or under a compromise –
(a) A corporation;
(b) A person who is under 21 years of age;
(c) A creditor of the company under administration;
(d) A person who has, within the 2 years immediately before the
commencement of the administration, been a shareholder, director,
auditor, or receiver of the company or of a related company;
(e) An undischarged bankrupt;
(f) A person in respect of whom a trustee order is in force under section
501 of the Niue Act 1966, or in respect of whom an order of medical
custody is in force under section 602 of that Act;
(g) A person who is prohibited from being a director or promoter of,
or being concerned or taking part in the management of, a company
under this Act;
(h) A person who is prohibited from acting as a liquidator under this
Act.

2 Validity of acts of administrators

The acts of a person as an administrator are valid even though that person
may not be qualified to act as an administrator.

3 Person must consent to being appointed administrator

(1) A person must not be appointed as administrator of a company or under
a compromise unless the person has consented in writing to the appointment.
(2) The administrator must deliver a copy of his or her consent to
appointment to the Registrar with the notice of his or her appointment.

4 Court may declare whether administrator validly appointed

(1) If there is doubt on a specific ground about whether the appointment
of a person as administrator of a company is valid, the person, the company, or
any of the company’s creditors may apply to the Court for an order under subclause
(2).

Companies Act 2006

531
(2) The Court may, on application, make an order declaring whether or not the appointment was valid on the ground specified in the application or on some other ground.

Vacancy in office of administrator

5 Vacancy in office of administrator

(1) The person who appointed an administrator of a company may appoint
someone else as administrator of the company if the administrator –
(a) Dies; or
(b) Becomes prohibited from acting as administrator of the company;
or
(c) Resigns by notice in writing given to his or her appointer and to
the company.
(2) Where the board of directors of a company appointed the administrator
of the company, an appointment under subclause (1) may be made by the board
despite clause 2 of Schedule 10.
(3) If a company is under administration, but for some reason no
administrator is acting, the Court may appoint a person as administrator on the
application of the Registrar or a creditor or shareholder of the company or, despite
clause 2 of Schedule 10, of an officer of the company.

6 Replacement administrator to hold creditors’ meeting

(1) Within 10 working days after being appointed as administrator of a
company under clause 5 otherwise than by the Court, the administrator must
hold a meeting of the company’s creditors in accordance with Schedule 12 so that
they may determine whether to appoint someone else as administrator of the
company.
(2) At least 5 working days before a creditors’ meeting is held under this
clause, the administrator must give –
(a) Written notice of the meeting to every secured party who holds a
registered charge over the property of the company; and
(b) Written notice of the meeting to as many of the company’s other
creditors as is reasonably practicable; and
(c) Public notice of the meeting.

7 Court order if vacancy in office of administrator

(1) The Court may make such order as it thinks just if the Court is satisfied
that –
(a) A company is under administration but –
(i) there is a vacancy in the office of administrator of the company;
or
(ii) no administrator of the company is acting; or
(b) A compromise approved under subpart 2 of Part 9 has not yet
terminated; but –
(i) there is a vacancy in the office of administrator under the
compromise; or
(ii) no administrator under the compromise is acting.
(2) The Registrar, or a creditor or shareholder of the company, are the only
persons who may apply for an order under subclause (1).
532 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

8 Vacancy in office of administrator under compromise

(1) The Court may appoint someone else as administrator under a
compromise if the administrator –
(a) Dies; or
(b) Becomes prohibited from acting as administrator under the
compromise; or
(c) Resigns by notice in writing given to the company.
(2) If a compromise has not yet terminated, but for some reason no
administrator under the compromise is acting, the Court may appoint a person as
administrator under the compromise.
(3) An appointment may be made on the application of the Registrar or of
an officer, shareholder, or creditor of the company.

Administrators’ remuneration

9 Remuneration of administrator

(1) The administrator of a company under administration, or acting under
a compromise approved by creditors in accordance with section 188(1)(a), is entitled
to –
(a) Any remuneration that is –
(i) fixed by a resolution of the company’s creditors passed at a
meeting convened under section 184; or
(ii) specified by the document setting out the terms of the
compromise; or
(b) If no remuneration is fixed, any remuneration that the Court fixes
on the application of the administrator.
(2) Despite clause 2 of Schedule 10, if remuneration is fixed under subclause
(1)(a), the Court may review the remuneration and confirm, increase, or reduce it
on the application of –
(a) The administrator of the company; or
(b) A director of the company; or
(c) A shareholder of the company; or
(d) A creditor of the company.
––––––––––––––––––––
SCHEDULE 10
EFFECT OF ADMINISTRATION

PART 1 PART 3

s 156(2)(c)

PRELIMINARY PROVISION EFFECT ON PROCEEDINGS, ETC

1 Time for doing act does not run while act 5 Stay of civil proceedings

prevented by administration 6 Suspension of enforcement process

7 Duties of court officer in relation to

PART 2 property of company

EFFECT ON COMPANYS OFFICERS AND 8 Court officer must deliver company

SHAREHOLDERS, ETC property, etc, to administrator

2 Functions and powers of company officers 9 Good faith buyer under execution process

suspended gets good title

3 Effect on company’s shareholders

4 Restrictions on putting company into

liquidation

Companies Act 2006

533

PART 4

RESTRICTIONS ON DEALING WITH

COMPANYS PROPERTY

General provisions

10

Only administrator may deal with

company’s property

11

Offence for company officer to enter into

12

Order for compensation

13

Owner or lessor not to recover property

used by company

14

Exception: perishable property

15

Exception: recovery of property before

administration

16

Court may limit powers of receiver, etc, in

relation to property used by company

17

Giving notice relating to property used by

company

Secured creditors

18

Charge unenforceable

PART 1
PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1 Time for doing act does not run while act prevented by administration

If, for any purpose, an act must or may be done within a particular period
or before a particular time, and this Act prevents the act from being done within
that period or before that time, the period is extended, or the time is deferred,
according to how long this Act prevented the act from being done.
PART 2
EFFECT ON COMPANYS OFFICERS AND SHAREHOLDERS, ETC

2 Functions and powers of company officers suspended

(1) Subject to clauses 19, 20(2), 22, and 23(3), while a company is under
administration, no person (other than the administrator) may, without the
administrator ’s written approval, perform a function, or exercise a power, as an
officer of the company.
(2) Subsection (1) does not have the effect of removing an officer of a
company from his or her office.

3 Effect of administration on company’s shareholders

A transfer of shares in a company, or an alteration in the status of
shareholders of a company, that is made during the administration of the company
is void except –
(a) With the consent of the administrator; or
(b) So far as the Court otherwise orders.

4 Restrictions on putting company into liquidation

If a company is under administration –
(a) The shareholders and the directors of the company must not appoint
a liquidator;
534 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) If the Court is satisfied that it is in the interests of the company’s creditors for the company to continue under administration, rather than for a liquidator or an interim liquidator to be appointed, as the case may be –
(i) the Court must adjourn the hearing of an application for an order to appoint a liquidator; and
(ii) the Court must not appoint an interim liquidator.
PART 3
EFFECT ON PROCEEDINGS, ETC

5 Stay of civil proceedings

During the administration of a company, a civil proceeding in a Court
against the company or in relation to any of its property must not be started or
proceeded with, except with –
(a) The administrator ’s written consent; or
(b) The leave of the Court and in accordance with any conditions that
the Court imposes.

6 Suspension of enforcement process

During the administration of a company, any enforcement process in relation
to property of the company must not be started or proceeded with, except –
(a) With the leave of the Court; and
(b) In accordance with any conditions that the Court imposes.

7 Duties of court officer in relation to property of company

A court officer who receives written notice of the fact that a company is
under administration must not –
(a) Take action to sell property of the company under a process of
execution; or
(b) Pay to a person who is not the administrator –
(i) proceeds of selling property of the company (at any time) under
a process of execution; or
(ii) money of the company seized (at any time) under a process of
execution; or
(iii) money paid (at any time) to avoid seizure or sale of property
of the company under a process of execution; or
(c) Take action in relation to the attachment of a debt due to the
company; or
(d) Pay to a person (other than the administrator) money received
because of the attachment of such a debt.

8 Court officer must deliver company property, etc, to administrator

(1) The court officer must –
(a) Deliver to the administrator any property of the company that is
ever in the court officer ’s possession under a process of execution;
and
(b) Pay to the administrator all proceeds or money of a kind referred
to in clause 7(b) or (d) that –
(i) are in the court officer ’s possession; or
(ii) have been paid into the Court and have not since been paid
out.

Companies Act 2006

535
(2) The costs of the execution or attachment are a first charge on property delivered, or proceeds or money paid, to the administrator.
(3) In order to give effect to a charge on proceeds or money, the
court officer may retain, on behalf of the person entitled to the charge, so much of
the proceeds or money as the court officer thinks necessary.
(4) The Court may, if it is satisfied that it is appropriate to do so, permit the
court officer to take action, or to make a payment, that would otherwise be
prevented.

9 Good faith buyer under execution process gets good title

Despite anything in clauses 7 and 8, a person who buys property in good
faith under a sale under a process of execution gets a good title to the property as
against the company and the administrator.
PART 4
RESTRICTIONS ON DEALING WITH COMPANYS PROPERTY

General provisions

10 Only administrator may deal with company’s property

(1) A transaction or dealing that affects property of a company under
administration is void unless –
(a) The administrator entered into it on the company’s behalf; or
(b) The administrator consented to it in writing before it was entered
into; or
(c) It was entered into under an order of the Court.
(2) Subclause (1) has effect subject to any order that the Court makes after
the transaction or dealing.

11 Offence for company officer to enter into void transaction or dealing

(1) Every officer of a company that is under administration commits an
offence if the officer of the company –
(a) Purported to enter into a void transaction or dealing on the
company’s behalf; or
(b) Was in any other way, by act or omission, directly or indirectly,
knowingly concerned in, or party to, the void transaction or dealing.
(2) Every officer of a company who commits an offence against subclause
(1) is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.

12 Order for compensation

(1) The Court may order a person who has been convicted of an offence
against clause 11(1) to pay compensation of a specified amount to the company or
other person who has suffered loss or damage as a result of the offence.
(2) An order under subclause (1) may be enforced as if it were a judgment
of the Court.
(3) The defences available under section 76 to relieve a person from liability
for an offence referred to in that section extend to relieving a person from liability
to be ordered under this clause to pay compensation.

13 Owner or lessor not to recover property used by company

During the administration of a company, the owner or lessor of property
that is used or occupied by, or is in the possession of, the company must not take
possession of the property or otherwise recover it, except –
536 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) Eith the administrator ’s written consent; or
(b) With the leave of the Court.

14 Exception: perishable property

(1) Nothing in clauses 2 or 13 prevents a person from taking possession of,
or otherwise recovering, perishable property.
(2) Clause 10 does not apply in relation to a transaction or dealing that –
(a) Affects perishable property; and
(b) Is entered into for the purpose of enforcing a right of the owner or
lessor of the property to take possession of the property or otherwise
recover it.

15 Exception: recovery of property before administration

If, before the beginning of the administration of a company, a receiver or
other person, for the purpose of enforcing a right of the owner or lessor of property
that is used or occupied by, or in possession of, the company, enters into possession
or assumes control of, or exercises any other power in relation to, the property –
(a) Nothing in clauses 2 or 13 prevents the receiver or other person
from performing a function, or exercising a power, in relation to
the property; and
(b) Clause 10 does not apply in relation to a transaction or dealing that
affects the property and is entered into in the performance of a
function, or exercise of a power, of the receiver or other person.

16 Court may limit powers of receiver, etc, in relation to property used by company

(1) Despite clauses 14 and 15, the Court may, on application by the administrator of a company, order a person not to perform specified functions, or exercise specified powers, in relation to property –
(a) That is used or occupied by, or in the possession of, the company;
and
(b) In respect of which the person, for the purpose of enforcing a right
as owner or lessor of the property, has entered into possession,
assumed control, or exercised any other power.
(2) The Court may make an order only if it is satisfied that what the
administrator proposes to do during the administration will adequately protect
the interests of the owner or lessor.
(3) An order may be made under this clause, and has effect, only during
the administration of the company.

17 Giving notice relating to property used by company

Nothing in clauses 2 or 13 prevents a person from giving a notice to a
company under an agreement relating to property that is used or occupied by, or
is in the possession of, the company.

18 Charge unenforceable

Secured creditors

Subject to clauses 20, 22, and 23, during the administration of a company, a person must not enforce a charge on property of the company, except –
(a) With the administrator ’s written consent; or
(b) With the leave of the Court.

Companies Act 2006

537

19 Exception: charge on perishable property

Despite anything in this schedule, a secured creditor who has a charge over
perishable property of a company under administration, or a receiver or other
appointed person who is entitled to enforce the charge, may –
(a) Enforce the charge on the perishable property;
(b) Enter into a transaction or dealing that affects the perishable
property.

20 Exception: enforcement of charge before administration

(1) If, before the beginning of the administration of a company, a secured
creditor, receiver, or other person, has, for the purpose of enforcing a charge on
property of the company, done any of the things specified in subclause (2) –
(a) Nothing in clauses 2 or 18 prevents the secured creditor, receiver,
or other person from enforcing the charge in relation to the property;
and
(b) Clause 10 does not apply in relation to a transaction or dealing that
affects the property and is entered into –
(i) in the exercise of a power of the secured creditor as secured
creditor; or
(ii) in the performance of a function, or exercise of a power, of the
receiver or other person.
(2) The things referred to in subclause (1) are the secured creditor as secured
creditor or the receiver or other person has –
(a) Entered into possession, or assumed control, of property of the
company; or
(b) Entered into an agreement to sell the property; or
(c) Made arrangements for the property to be offered for sale by public
auction; or
(d) Publicly invited tenders for the purchase of the property; or
(e) Exercised any other power in relation to the property.

21 Court may limit powers of secured creditor, etc, in relation to charged property

(1) Despite clauses 19 and 20, the Court may, on application by the administrator of a company, order a secured creditor, receiver, or other person not to perform specified functions or exercise specified powers if, for the purpose of enforcing a charge on property of a company, the secured creditor, receiver, or other person, does an act of a kind referred to in clause 19.
(2) Subclause (1) does not apply in a case to which clause 23 applies.
(3) The Court may make an order only if it is satisfied that what the
administrator proposes to do during the administration will adequately protect
the secured creditor ’s interests.
(4) An order may be made under this clause, and has effect, only during
the administration of the company.

22 Giving notice under charge

Nothing in clauses 2 or 18 prevents a person from giving a notice under the
charge.
538 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

23 When secured creditor acts before or during decision period

(1) This clause applies if –
(a) All of the property of a company under administration is subject to
a charge; and
(b) Before or during the decision period, the secured creditor enforced
the charge in relation to all property of the company subject to the
charge, whether or not the charge was enforced in the same way in
relation to all that property.
(2) This clause also applies if –
(a) A company is under administration; and
(b) The same person is the secured creditor in relation to each of 2 or
more charges on property of the company; and
(c) The property of the company subject to the respective charges
together constitutes all, or almost all, of the company’s property;
and
(d) Before or during the decision period, the secured creditor enforced
the charges in relation to all the charged property –
(i) whether or not the charges were enforced in the same way in
relation to all the charged property; and
(ii) whether or not any of the charges were enforced in the same
way in relation to all the property of the company subject to
that charge; and
(iii) in so far as the charges were enforced in relation to property of
the company in a way referred to in paragraphs (a), (b), or (d)
of the definition of enforce in clause 1 of Schedule 1, whether
or not the same person was appointed in respect of all of that
property.
(3) Nothing in clauses 2 or 18 prevents any of the following from enforcing
the charge, or any of the charges –
(a) The secured creditor entitled to the charge or charges;
(b) A receiver or person referred to in paragraphs (a), (b), or (d) of the
definition of enforce in clause 1 of Schedule 1, as that definition
applies in relation to the charge or any of the charges (even if
appointed after the decision period).
(4) Clause 10 does not apply in relation to a transaction or dealing that
affects property of the company and is entered into by the secured creditor, a
receiver, or person of a kind referred to in subclause (3)(b), in the performance of
a function, or exercise of a power, as secured creditor, or as a receiver, or person,
as the case may be.
PART 5
EFFECT ON GUARANTEES

24 Administration not to trigger liability under guarantee

Except with the leave of the Court and in accordance with any conditions
that the Court imposes, during the administration of a company –
(a) A guarantee of a liability of the company must not be enforced as
against –
(i) a director or shareholder of the company who is a natural
person; or
(ii) a spouse or relative of the director or shareholder; and
(b) Without limiting paragraph (a), a proceeding, in relation to a
guarantee, must not be started against a director, shareholder,
spouse, or relative.

Companies Act 2006

539

25 Court orders

(1) Despite clause 24, the Court may, on application by the creditor, make
1 or more of the following orders –
(a) An order prohibiting a person who is indebted to the guarantor or
to an associate of the guarantor from making a payment in total or
partial discharge of the debt to, or to another person at the direction
or request of, the person to whom the debt is owed;
(b) An order prohibiting a person holding money, securities, futures
contracts or other property, on behalf of the guarantor, or on behalf
of an associate of the guarantor, from paying all or any of the money,
or transferring, or otherwise parting with possession of, the
securities, futures contracts or other property, to, or to another
person at the direction or request of, the person on whose behalf
the money, securities, futures contracts or other property, is or are
held;
(c) An order prohibiting the taking or sending out of the jurisdiction
of Niue by a person, money of the guarantor or of an associate of
the guarantor;
(d) An order prohibiting the taking, sending or transfer by a person of
securities, futures contracts or other property of the guarantor, or
of an associate of the guarantor –
(i) from a place under the jurisdiction of Niue to a place outside
the jurisdiction (including the transfer of securities from a
register in the jurisdiction of Niue to a register outside that
jurisdiction); or
(ii) from a place in Niue to a place outside Niue (including the
transfer of securities from a register in Niue to a register outside
Niue);
(e) An order appointing, a receiver or trustee, having such powers as
the Court orders, of the property or of part of the property of a
person who is an individual;
(f) An order appointing a receiver, having such powers as the Court
orders, of all or any part of the property of a guarantor who is a
body corporate;
(g) An order prohibiting a guarantor who is an individual from leaving
Niue without the consent of the Court.
(2) A reference in subclause (1)(d), (e), or (f) to property of a person includes
reference to property that the person holds otherwise than as sole beneficial owner,
for example –
(a) As trustee for, as nominee for, or otherwise on behalf of or on account
of, another person; or
(b) In a fiduciary capacity.
(3) An order under subclause (1) prohibiting conduct may prohibit the
conduct either absolutely or subject to conditions.

26 Grounds for making order under clause 25

The Court may make an order under clause 25 if the Court considers it
necessary or desirable to do so for the purpose of protecting the interests of the creditor to whom a guarantor is liable, or may become liable, to pay money, whether in respect of a debt, by way of damages or compensation or otherwise, or to account for securities, futures contracts, or other property.
540 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

27 Interim order

If an application is made to the Court for an order under clause 25, the
Court may, if in the opinion of the Court it is desirable to do so, before considering
the application, grant an interim order (being an order of the kind applied for)
that is expressed to have effect pending the determination of the application.

28 No undertaking as to damages

On an application under clause 25, the Court must not require the applicant
or any other person, as a condition of granting an interim order, to give an
undertaking as to damages.

29 Variation or discharge of order

If the Court has made an order on a person’s application under clause 25,
the Court may, on application by that person or by any person affected by the
order, make a further order discharging or varying the first order.

30 Operation of orders

An order made under clauses 25 or 27 may be expressed to operate for a
specified period or until the order is discharged by a further order.

SCHEDULE 11
CREDITORS’ COMMITTEES

1 Functions of committees of creditors

s 156
(1) The functions of a committee of creditors of a company under administration are –
(a) To consult with the administrator about matters relating to the
administration; and
(b) To receive and consider reports by the administrator.
(2) A committee must not give directions to the administrator, except as
provided in subclause (3).
(3) As and when a committee reasonably requires, the administrator must
report to the committee about matters relating to the administration.
(4) Schedule 12, with the necessary modifications, applies to meetings of
committees of creditors.

2 Membership of committee

A person may be a member of a committee of creditors of a company under
administration if, and only if, he or she is –
(a) A creditor of the company; or
(b) The attorney of such a creditor because of a general power of
attorney; or
(c) Authorised in writing by such a creditor to be such a member.
––––––––––––––––––––

Companies Act 2006

SCHEDULE 12
MEETINGS OF CREDITORS
541
ss 156, 205, 206, 211

Proxies

13

Administrator or liquidator may act as

proxy

14

Irregularity in notice of proxy

15

Limits on holder of proxy

Voting

16

Entitlement to vote, etc, determined by

chairperson

17

Voting by secured creditors

18

When resolution adopted

Postal voting

19

Who may cast postal vote

20

Postal vote cast in respect of different

resolution

21

Person authorised to receive and count

postal votes

22

How to cast postal vote

23

Duty of person authorised to receive and

count postal votes

24

Duty of chairperson

1 Procedure generally

General provisions

Except as provided in this schedule and in any regulations made under this Act, a meeting of creditors may regulate its own procedure.

2 Effect of irregularity or defect

(1) An irregularity or defect in the proceedings at a meeting of creditors
does not invalidate anything done by a meeting of creditors, unless the Court
orders otherwise.
(2) The Court may, on the application of the administrator or liquidator, as
the case may be, or a creditor of the company, make an order under subclause (1)
if it is satisfied that substantial injustice would be caused if the order were not
made.

Methods of holding meetings

3 Methods of holding meetings

A meeting of creditors may be held –
(a) By assembling together those creditors entitled to take part and
who choose to attend at the place, date, and time appointed for the
meeting by the person convening the meeting as being in his or her
opinion the most convenient place, date, and time for the majority
of creditors; or
(b) By means of audio, or audio and visual, communication by which
all creditors participating may simultaneously hear each other
throughout the meeting; or
(c) By conducting a postal ballot, in accordance with clauses 19 to 24,
of those creditors entitled to take part.
542 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

4 Notice of meeting

Notice of meeting

At least 5 working days before a creditors meeting, written notice must be sent to every creditor entitled to attend the meeting of –
(a) The time and place of every meeting to be held under clause 3(a);
or
(b) The time and method of communication for every meeting to be
held under clause 3(b); or
(c) The time and address for the return of voting papers for every
meeting to be held under clause 3(a), (b), or (c).

5 Contents of notice

The notice must –
(a) State the nature of the business to be transacted at the meeting in
sufficient detail to enable a creditor to form a reasoned judgment in
relation to it; and
(b) Set out the text of any resolution to be submitted to the meeting;
and
(c) Include a voting paper in respect of each such resolution and voting
and mailing instructions; and
(d) State that if a creditor votes by casting a postal vote in respect of a
resolution that is to be submitted to the meeting and a different
resolution is submitted to the meeting –
(i) the creditor ’s postal vote is invalid in respect of that different
resolution; but
(ii) the creditor may vote, in respect of that different resolution,
either by being present in person or by proxy.

6 Effect of irregularity, etc, in notice

An irregularity in or a failure to receive a notice of a meeting of creditors
does not invalidate anything done by a meeting of creditors if –
(a) The irregularity or failure is not material; or
(b) All the creditors entitled to attend and vote at the meeting attend
the meeting without protest as to the irregularity or failure; or
(c) All such creditors agree to waive the irregularity or failure.

7 Adjournment of meeting

Meeting

(1) If the meeting of creditors agrees, the chairperson may adjourn the meeting from time to time and from place to place.
(2) An adjourned meeting must be held in the same place unless another
place is specified in the resolution for the adjournment.
(3) If a meeting of creditors under clause 3(a) or (b) is adjourned for less
than 30 days, it is not necessary to give notice of the time and place of the adjourned
meeting other than by announcement at the meeting that is adjourned.

8 Chairperson

(1) If an administrator or liquidator, as the case may be, has been appointed
and is present, or if the administrator or liquidator has appointed a nominee and
the nominee is present, he or she must act as the chairperson of a meeting held in
accordance with clause 3(a) or (b).

Companies Act 2006

543
(2) At any meeting of creditors, if the administrator or liquidator or any nominee of the administrator or liquidator, as is applicable, is not present, or if there is no administrator or liquidator holding office for the time being, the creditors participating must choose 1 of their number to act as the chairperson of the meeting. (3) The person convening a meeting under clause 3(c) must do everything
necessary that would otherwise be done by the person chairing a meeting.

9 Quorum

(1) A quorum for a meeting of creditors is present if –
(a) 3 creditors who are entitled to vote or their proxies are present or
have cast postal votes; or
(b) If the number of creditors entitled to vote does not exceed 3, the
creditors who are entitled to vote or their proxies are present or
have cast postal votes.
(2) If a quorum is not present within 30 minutes after the time appointed
for the meeting, the meeting is adjourned to the same day in the following week
at the same time and place, or to such other date, time, and place as the chairperson
may appoint, and if, at the adjourned meeting, a quorum is not present within 30
minutes after the time appointed for the meeting, the creditors present or their
proxies are a quorum.

10 Corporations may act by representatives

A body corporate that is a creditor may appoint a representative to attend
a meeting of creditors on its behalf.

11 Keeping of record of attendance and minutes

(1) The chairperson of a meeting of creditors, or in the case of a meeting
held under clause 3(c), the person convening the meeting must –
(a) Ensure that an accurate record is kept of all creditors present or
represented at the meeting, including –
(i) the name of each creditor present or represented; and
(ii) whether the creditor has made a claim, and the amount of the
claim; and
(iii) whether the creditor has filed a proxy or is present in person;
and
(iv) the total number of creditors present or represented; and
(b) Ensure that minutes are kept of all proceedings.
(2) Records of attendance or minutes that have been signed correct by the
chairperson or the person convening the meeting are prima facie evidence of the
details recorded and proceedings of the meeting.

12 Proxies

Proxies

(1) A creditor may exercise the right to vote either by being present in person or by proxy.
(2) A proxy for a creditor is entitled to attend and be heard at a meeting of creditors as if the proxy were the creditor.
(3) A proxy must be appointed by notice in writing signed by the creditor and the notice must state whether the appointment is for a particular meeting or a specified term not exceeding 12 months.
(4) No proxy is effective in relation to a meeting unless a copy of the notice of appointment is delivered to the administrator or liquidator, as the case may be,
544 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
or, if no administrator or liquidator is acting in respect of a company in administration or liquidation, to the person by whom the notice convening the meeting was given, not less than 2 working days before the start of the meeting.

13 Administrator or liquidator may act as proxy

(1) A creditor may appoint any person, including the administrator or
liquidator or, if there is no administrator or liquidator, the chairperson of a meeting,
to act as his or her proxy.
(2) Subject to a direction of a meeting of creditors, an administrator or
liquidator must not solicit for proxies.
(3) Without limiting the orders that a Court may make, if an administrator
or liquidator, as the case may be, has not complied with subclause (2), the Court
may –
(a) Order that the administrator or liquidator is not entitled to his or her remuneration;
(b) Make an order removing the administrator or liquidator from office; (c) Make an order declaring any transaction entered into by the administrator or liquidator to be void or overturning any vote, and
granting such consequential relief as the Court thinks fit.

14 Irregularity in notice of proxy

If an irregularity that is not material is contained in the notice of proxy, the
administrator or liquidator or chairperson of a meeting, as the case may be, may
accept the proxy as being valid for voting purposes, if he or she is satisfied that
the proxy holder represents the creditor.

15 Limits on holder of proxy

(1) Subject to subclause (2), no person acting under a proxy may vote in
favour of or against any resolution that would place that person, either directly or
indirectly, in a position to receive any benefit out of the assets of the company
otherwise than as a creditor rateably with the other creditors of the company.
(2) Any person who holds a proxy to vote for the appointment of an
administrator or liquidator, as the case may be, may use the proxy to vote in favour
of the appointment of himself or herself as administrator or liquidator if it is not
inconsistent with the terms of the proxy to do so.
(3) If an administrator or liquidator, as the case may be, who holds a proxy
cannot attend a meeting of creditors called under this Act, he or she may, in writing,
nominate his or her partner (if the administrator or liquidator or the administrator
or liquidator is a member of a partnership) or some person in his or her
employment, to use the proxy on his or her behalf and in such manner as he or
she may direct.
(4) Nothing in subclause (3) authorises the person nominated to vote in a
manner that would be in contravention of subclauses (1) and (2) if the administrator
or liquidator had acted under the proxy personally.

Voting

16 Entitlement to vote, etc, determined by chairperson

(1) For the purpose of determining whether a person is allowed to vote at
a meeting and the value of the person’s claim for voting purposes, the chairperson
has the power to determine, for the purpose of the meeting –
(a) That the person is a creditor of the company; and
(b) The value of a creditor ’s claim against the company.

Companies Act 2006

545
(2) If the chairperson is uncertain as to whether a person is a creditor of the company or as to the value of the person’s claim against the company, the chairperson must allow the person to vote subject to the vote being subsequently declared invalid in whole or in part by the chairperson.
(3) A creditor who is not entitled to vote, may, with the leave of the administrator or liquidator, attend and speak at a meeting of creditors.
(4) A creditor chairing the meeting does not have a casting vote.

17 Voting by secured creditors

(1) In the case of a meeting of creditors held under subpart 1 of Part 9
(administrations) –
(a) A secured creditor is entitled to vote at the meeting;
(b) A secured creditor who votes at the meeting is not taken to have
surrendered his or her charge over any property of the company.
(2) In the case of a meeting of creditors held under subpart 3 of Part 9
(liquidations) –
(a) A secured creditor is entitled to vote –
(i) for the whole debt if he or she surrenders the charge to the
liquidator for the general benefit of creditors; or
(ii) in respect of the balance of the debt if he or she values the charge
and claims as an unsecured creditor for the balance due; or
(iii) in respect of the balance of the debt if he or she realises property
subject to a charge and claims as an unsecured creditor for any
balance due after deducting the net amount realised;
(b) Subject to this Act, if a secured creditor votes in respect of the
creditor ’s whole debt, the creditor is taken to have surrendered his
or her charge;
(c) A creditor who is not entitled to vote may, with the leave of the
liquidator, attend and speak at the meeting.

18 When resolution adopted

At any meeting of creditors or a class of creditors, a resolution is adopted if
a majority in number and value of the creditors or the class of creditors voting in
person or by proxy or by postal vote, vote in favour of the resolution.

19 Who may cast postal vote

Postal voting

A creditor entitled to vote at a meeting of creditors held in accordance with clause 3(a), (b), or (c) may exercise the right to vote by casting a postal vote in relation to a matter to be decided at that meeting.

20 Postal vote cast in respect of different resolution

If a creditor votes by casting a postal vote in respect of a resolution that is
to be submitted to the meeting and a different resolution is submitted to the
meeting –
(a) The creditor ’s postal vote is invalid in respect of that different resolution; but
(b) The creditor may vote, in respect of that different resolution, either by being present in person or by proxy.
546 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

21 Person authorised to receive and count postal votes

(1) The notice of meeting must state the name of the person authorised to
receive and count postal votes in relation to that meeting.
(2) If no person has been authorised to receive and count postal votes in
relation to a meeting, or if no person is named as being so authorised in the notice
of the meeting, the administrator or liquidator is deemed to be so authorised.

22 How to cast postal vote

A creditor may cast a postal vote on all or any of the matters to be voted on
at the meeting by sending a marked voting paper to a person authorised to receive
and count postal votes in relation to that meeting, so as to reach that person not
less than 2 working days before the start of the meeting or, if the meeting is held
under clause 3(c), not later than the date named for the return of the voting paper.

23 Duty of person authorised to receive and count postal votes

(1) It is the duty of a person authorised to receive and count postal votes
in relation to a meeting –
(a) To collect together all postal votes received by him or her; and
(b) In relation to each resolution to be voted on –
(i) to count the number of creditors or creditors belonging to a
class of creditors, as the case may be, voting in favour of the
resolution and determine the total amount of the debts owed
by the company to those creditors; and
(ii) to count the number of creditors or creditors belonging to a
class of creditors, as the case may be, voting against the
resolution and determine the total amount of the debts owed
by the company to those creditors; and
(c) To sign a certificate –
(i) that he or she has carried out the duties set out in paragraphs
(a) and (b); and
(ii) stating the results of the counts and determinations required
by paragraph (b); and
(d) To ensure that the certificate required by paragraph (c) is presented
to the person chairing or convening the meeting.
(2) A certificate given under subclause (1) in relation to the postal votes
cast in respect of a meeting of creditors must be annexed to the minutes of the
meeting.

24 Duty of chairperson

If a vote is taken at a meeting held under clause 3(a) or (b) on a resolution
on which postal votes have been cast, the person chairing the meeting must include
the results of voting by all creditors who have sent in a voting paper duly marked
as for or against the resolution.
––––––––––––––––––––

Companies Act 2006

SCHEDULE 13
POWERS, FUNCTIONS, AND LIABILITIES OF LIQUIDATORS
547
s 211

PART 1

PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1

Power to appoint 2 or more liquidators

2

Liquidators to act jointly

3

When liquidator not required to act

PART 2

POWERS OF LIQUIDATORS

4

Liquidator controls company’s assets

5

General powers

6

Specific powers

7

Liquidator may enforce liability of

shareholders

8

Liquidator may disclaim onerous property

9

Liquidator may be required to elect

whether to disclaim onerous property

PART 3

DUTIES OF LIQUIDATORS

10

Principal duties of liquidator

11

Restriction on purchase of company’s

PART 1
PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1 Power to appoint 2 or more liquidators

For the purposes of this Act, the power to appoint a liquidator of a company
includes the power to appoint 2 or more persons as liquidators of a company.

2 Liquidators to act jointly

If 2 or more persons are appointed as liquidators of a company, those persons
must act jointly unless the special resolution of shareholders, the resolution of the
directors of the company, or the order of the Court appointing the liquidators
states that the liquidators may exercise their powers individually.

3 When liquidator not required to act

Despite anything in this Act, except if the charge is surrendered or taken to be
surrendered or redeemed, a liquidator may, but is not required to, carry out any
duty or exercise any power in relation to property that is subject to a charge.
PART 2
POWERS OF LIQUIDATORS

4 Liquidator controls company’s assets

With effect from the commencement of the liquidation of a company, the
liquidator has custody and control of the company’s assets.

5 General powers

A liquidator has the powers –
(a) Necessary to carry out the functions and duties of a liquidator under
this Act; and
548

6

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

(b) Conferred on a liquidator by this Act.

Specific powers

Without limiting clause 5, a liquidator of a company has power to –
(a) Commence, continue, discontinue, and defend legal proceedings;
(b) Carry on the business of the company, to the extent necessary for
the liquidation;
(c) Appoint a solicitor;
(d) Pay any class of creditors in full;
(e) Make a compromise or an arrangement with creditors or persons
claiming to be creditors or who have or allege the existence of a
claim against the company, whether present or future, actual or
contingent, or ascertained or not;
(f) Compromise calls and liabilities for calls, debts, and liabilities
capable of resulting in debts, and claims, present or future, actual
or contingent, ascertained or not, subsisting or supposed to subsist
between the company and any person and all questions relating to,
or affecting the assets or the liquidation of, the company, on such
terms as may be agreed, and take security for the discharge of any
such call, debt, liability, or claim, and give a complete discharge;
(g) Sell or otherwise dispose of the property of the company;
(h) Act in the name and on behalf of the company and enter into deeds,
contracts, and arrangements in the name and on behalf of the
company;
(i) Prove, rank, and claim in the bankruptcy or insolvency of a
shareholder for any balance against that person’s estate, and to
receive dividends in the bankruptcy or insolvency, as a separate
debt due from the bankrupt or insolvent and rateably with the other
separate creditors;
(j) Draw, accept, make, and endorse a bill of exchange or promissory
note in the name and on behalf of the company, with the same effect
as if the bill or note had been drawn, accepted, made, or endorsed
by or on behalf of the company in the course of its business;
(k) Borrow money on the security of the company’s assets;
(l) Take out, in his or her name as liquidator, letters of administration
to a deceased shareholder, and to do in that name any other act
necessary for obtaining payment of money due from a shareholder
or his or her estate, that cannot be conveniently done in the name
of the company. In all such cases, the money due is, for the purpose
of enabling the liquidator to take out the letters of administration
or recover the money, deemed to be due to the liquidator;
(m) Call a meeting of creditors or shareholders for –
(i) the purpose of informing creditors or shareholders of progress
in the liquidation;
(ii) the purpose of ascertaining the views of creditors or
shareholders on any matter arising in the liquidation;
(iii) such other purpose connected with the liquidation as the
liquidator thinks fit;
(n) Appoint an agent to do anything that the liquidator is unable to do.

Companies Act 2006

549

7 Liquidator may enforce liability of shareholders

A liquidator may enforce the liability of the shareholder or former
shareholder in respect of any shares issued to the shareholder or former
shareholder.

8 Liquidator may disclaim onerous property

(1) Subject to clause 9, a liquidator may disclaim onerous property even
though the liquidator has taken possession of it, tried to sell it, or otherwise
exercised rights of ownership in relation to it.
(2) A disclaimer –
(a) Brings to an end, on and from the date of the disclaimer, the rights,
interests, and liabilities of the company in relation to the property
disclaimed;
(b) Does not, except so far as necessary to release the company from a
liability, affect the rights or liabilities of any other person.
(3) A liquidator who disclaims onerous property must, within 10 working
days of the disclaimer, give notice in writing of the disclaimer to every person
whose rights are, to the knowledge of the liquidator, affected by the disclaimer.
(4) A person suffering loss or damage as a result of a disclaimer under this
clause may –
(a) Claim as a creditor of the company for the amount of the loss or
damage, taking account of the effect of an order made by the Court
under paragraph (b);
(b) Apply to the Court for an order that the disclaimed property be
delivered to, or vested in, that person.
(5) The Court may make an order under subclause (4)(b) if it is satisfied
that it is just that the property should be vested in the applicant.

9 Liquidator may be required to elect whether to disclaim onerous property

A liquidator is not entitled to disclaim onerous property if –
(a) A person whose rights would be affected by the disclaimer of
onerous property gives the liquidator notice in writing requiring
the liquidator to elect whether to disclaim the onerous property
before the close of a date specified in the notice, which must be at
least 20 working days after the date on which the notice is received
by the liquidator; and
(b) The liquidator does not disclaim the onerous property before the
close of that date.
PART 3
DUTIES OF LIQUIDATORS

10 Principal duties of liquidator

The principal duties of a liquidator of a company are, in a reasonable and
efficient manner –
(a) To take possession of, protect, realise, and distribute the assets, or
the proceeds of the realisation of the assets, of the company to its
creditors in accordance with this Act; and
(b) If there are surplus assets remaining, to distribute them, or the
proceeds of the realisation of the surplus assets, in accordance with
section 250.
550 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

11 Restriction on purchase of company’s assets by liquidator

(1) Subject to the leave of the Court, a liquidator must not, either directly
or indirectly, become a purchaser of any part of the company’s assets.
(2) The Court may set aside any purchase made contrary to this clause,
and grant any consequential relief that it thinks fit.
(3) The Court may give its leave on any conditions that it thinks fit.

12 Restriction on purchase of goods or services from persons connected with liquidator

(1) Subject to the leave of the Court, a liquidator must not purchase goods or services for the purposes of the liquidation from any person whose connection with him or her would result in the liquidator directly or indirectly obtaining any benefit arising out of the transaction.
(2) The Court may disallow or recover any benefit made contrary to this
clause.
(3) The Court may give its leave on any conditions that it thinks fit.

13 Deposit of company funds

A liquidator must deposit the funds of a company under his or her
administration in a bank account to the credit of the company or in a trust account
at a bank on trust for the benefit of the company.

14 Investment of funds

(1) Despite clause 13, in any liquidation all or any part of the balance
standing to the credit of the company in any bank account or trust account kept
by the liquidator, and not required for the time being to meet claims made against
the company, may be invested in any bank or in any Government securities or, if
authorised by the Court, any other securities.
(2) All dividends, interest, and other profits from investments must
immediately on being received be paid into the bank account or trust account
kept by the liquidator under clause 13.

15 Duties in relation to accounts

(1) Subject to subclause (2), the liquidator of a company must –
(a) Keep accounts and records of the liquidation and permit those
accounts and records, and the accounts and records in the company,
to be inspected by –
(i) any appointed liquidation committee, unless the liquidator
believes on reasonable grounds that inspection would be
prejudicial to the liquidation; and
(ii) if the Court so orders, a creditor or shareholder; and
(b) Retain the accounts and records of the liquidation and of the
company for not less than 1 year after completion of the liquidation;
and
(c) If a liquidator carries on the business of the company, keep
accounting records for the carrying on of the business of the
company that comply with section 129 to the extent that that section
is applicable.
(2) The Registrar may, whether before or after the completion of the
liquidation –
(a) Authorise the disposal of any accounts and records; and
(b) Require any accounts or records to be retained for longer than 1
year after the completion of the liquidation.

Companies Act 2006

551

16 Meaning of failure to comply

In clauses 17 to 19, failure to comply means a failure of a liquidator to comply
with a relevant duty arising –
(a) Under this or any other Act or rule of law or rules of Court; or
(b) Under any order or direction of a Court other than an order to
comply made under clause 17.

17 Failure to comply

If the Court is satisfied that there is, or has been, a failure to comply, the
Court may –
(a) Relieve the liquidator of the duty to comply wholly or in part; or
(b) Without prejudice to any other remedy that may be available in
relation to a breach of duty by the liquidator, order the liquidator
to comply to the extent specified in the order.

18 Consequences of non-compliance with Court order

A Court may, in relation to a person who fails to comply with an order
made under clause 17, or is or becomes disqualified to become or remain a
liquidator –
(a) Remove the liquidator from office; or
(b) Order that the person may be appointed and act, or may continue
to act, as liquidator, despite being disqualified to act as liquidator.

19 Prohibition order

(1) The Court must make, in relation to a person, a prohibition order for a
period not exceeding 5 years if it is shown to the satisfaction of a Court that the
person is unfit to act as liquidator by reason of –
(a) Persistent failures to comply; or
(b) The seriousness of a failure to comply.
(2) A person to whom a prohibition order applies must not –
(a) Act as a liquidator in a current or other liquidation; or
(b) Act as a receiver in a current or other receivership; or
(c) Act as an administrator of a company under subpart 1 of Part 9.
(3) The following is, in the absence of special reasons to the contrary,
evidence of persistent failures to comply for the purposes of this clause –
(a) Evidence that on 2 or more occasions within the preceding 5 years,
a Court has made an order to comply under this clause in respect
of the same person;
(b) Evidence that on 2 or more occasions within the preceding 5 years,
an application for an order to comply under this clause has been
made in respect of the same person and that in each case the person
has complied after the making of the application and before the
hearing.
(4) A copy of every prohibition order must, within 10 working days of the
order being made, be delivered by the applicant to the Registrar, who must keep
it on a file indexed by reference to the name of the liquidator concerned.

20 Who may apply for orders under clauses 17 to 19

(1) An application for an order under this Part may be made by –
(a) A liquidator;
(b) A person seeking appointment as a liquidator;
(c) A liquidation committee;
552 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) A creditor, shareholder or a director of the company in liquidation; (e) A receiver appointed in relation to property of the company in
liquidation;
(f) The Registrar.
(2) No application may be made to a Court by a person other than a
liquidator in relation to a failure to comply unless notice of the failure to comply
has been served on the liquidator not less than 5 working days before the date of
the application and, as at the date of the application, there is a continuing failure
to comply.

21 Court orders under clauses 17 to 19: general

(1) In making an order under this clause, a Court may, if it thinks fit –
(a) Make an order extending the time for compliance; or
(b) Impose terms or conditions; or
(c) Make an ancillary order.

22 Court orders

PART 4
COURT SUPERVISION OF LIQUIDATIONS
On the application of the liquidator, a liquidation committee, or, with the leave of the Court, a creditor, shareholder, or director of a company in liquidation, the Court may –
(a) Give directions in relation to any matter arising in connection with the liquidation;
(b) Confirm, reverse, or modify an act or decision of the liquidator; (c) Order an audit of the accounts of the liquidation;
(d) Order the liquidator to produce the accounts and records of the
liquidation for audit and to provide the auditor with the information
concerning the conduct of the liquidation that the auditor requests;
(e) In respect of any period, review or fix the remuneration of the
liquidator at a level that is reasonable in the circumstances;
(f) To the extent that an amount retained by the liquidator as
remuneration is found by the Court to be unreasonable in the
circumstances, order the liquidator to refund the amount;
(g) Declare whether or not the liquidator was validly appointed or
validly assumed custody or control of property;
(h) Make an order concerning the retention or the disposition of the
accounts and records of the liquidation or of the company.

23 Court orders are additional to other Court powers

The powers given by clause 22 –
(a) Are in addition to any other powers a Court may exercise in its
jurisdiction relating to liquidators under this Act; and
(b) May be exercised –
(i) In relation to a matter occurring either before or after the
commencement of the liquidation or the removal of the
company from the Niue register; and
(ii) whether or not the liquidator has ceased to act as liquidator
when the application or the order is made.

Companies Act 2006

553

24 Defence to act in accordance with Court direction

(1) Subject to subclause (2), a liquidator is entitled to rely on having so
acted as a defence to a claim in relation to anything done or not done in accordance with the direction if the liquidator has –
(a) Obtained a direction of a Court with respect to a matter connected with the exercise of the powers or functions of liquidator; and
(b) Acted in accordance with the direction.
(2) A Court may, on the application of any person, order that, by reason of
the circumstances in which a direction by the Court was obtained, the liquidator
does not have the protection given by subclause (1).
––––––––––––––––––––
SCHEDULE 14
OFFICE OF LIQUIDATOR
s 211

RESTRICTIONS ON APPOINTMENT OF LIQUIDATORS

9 Appointment of liquidator until successor appointed

10 Appointment of successor by Court

11 Notice of appointment given by successor

12 Vacating liquidator ’s successor to be

helped

13 Liquidator ceases to hold office

oncompletion of liquidation

Liquidators’ remuneration

14 Remuneration of liquidators

15 Expenses and remuneration payable out

of assets of company

Restrictions on appointment of liquidators

1 Who may not be appointed or act as liquidator

None of the following may be appointed or act as a liquidator of a
company –
(a) A corporation;
(b) A person who is under 21 years of age;
(c) A creditor of the company;
(d) A person who has, within the 2 years immediately before the
beginning of the liquidation, been a shareholder, director, auditor,
or receiver of the company or of a related company;
(e) An undischarged bankrupt;
(f) A person in respect of whom a trustee order is in force under section
501 of the Niue Act 1966, or in respect of whom an order of medical
custody is in force under section 602 of that Act;
(g) A person who is prohibited from being a director or promoter, or
being concerned or taking part in the management, of a company
under this Act;
(h) A person who is prohibited from acting as an administrator under
this Act.
554 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

2 Validity of acts of liquidators

(1) The acts of a person as a liquidator are valid even though that person
may not be qualified to act as a liquidator.
(2) No defect or irregularity in the appointment of a liquidator invalidates
any act done by him or her in good faith.

3 Person must consent to being appointed liquidator

A person must not be appointed as liquidator of a company unless –
(a) The person has consented in writing to the appointment; and
(b) As at the time of the appointment, the person has not withdrawn
the consent.

4 Court may declare whether liquidator validly appointed

(1) If there is doubt on a specific ground about whether the appointment
of a person as liquidator of a company is valid, the person, the company, or any of
the company’s creditors may apply to the’Court for an order under subclause (2).
(2) The Court may, on application, make an order declaring whether or
not the appointment was valid on the ground specified in the application or on
some other ground.

Vacancy in office of liquidator

5 Vacancy in office of liquidator

The office of liquidator becomes vacant if the person holding office resigns,
dies, or is or becomes disqualified to act as liquidator.

6 How liquidator may resign

A person may resign from the office of liquidator by appointing another
person as his or her successor and sending or delivering notice in writing of the
appointment of his or her successor to the Registrar for registration.

7 Court may review appointment of successor

The Court may, on the application of the company, or a shareholder or
other entitled person, or a director or creditor of the company, review the
appointment of a successor to a liquidator and may appoint any person who could
be appointed as liquidator under sections 214, 215, or 217, as the case may be, to
be the liquidator of the company.

8 Vacancy not caused by resignation

If, for any reason other than resignation, a vacancy occurs in the office of
liquidator, written notice of the vacancy must immediately be sent or delivered to
the Registrar by the person vacating office or, if that person is unable to act, by his
or her personal representative.

9 Appointment of liquidator until successor appointed

If, as the result of the vacation of office by a liquidator, no person is acting
as liquidator, the Registrar may appoint a person to act as liquidator until a
successor is appointed under this clause.

10 Appointment of successor by Court

If a vacancy occurs in the office of the liquidator, or a liquidator has been
appointed under clause 9, as the case may be, the Court may, on the application of
the company, or a shareholder or other entitled person, or a director or creditor of

Companies Act 2006

555
the company, or the Registrar, appoint any person who could be appointed as liquidator under sections 214, 215, or 217, as the case may be, to be the liquidator of the company.

11 Notice of appointment given by successor

A liquidator appointed under clause 10 must, within 10 working days of
being appointed or being notified of his or her appointment, deliver a notice of
his or her appointment to the Registrar for registration.

12 Vacating liquidator’s successor to be helped

(1) A person vacating the office of liquidator must, if practicable, provide
such information and give such assistance to that person’s successor as he or she
reasonably requires in taking over the duties of liquidator.
(2) A person vacating the office of liquidator must immediately, or within
any reasonable time that may be specified by that person’s successor, deliver to
his or her successor the following things that are in his or her possession or under
his or her control –
(a) Any records or documents of the company;
(b) Other property of the company;
(c) All claims;
(d) Accounts and records of the liquidation.

13 Liquidator ceases to hold office on completion of liquidation

(1) A liquidator ceases to hold office on the completion of the liquidation.
(2) Subclause (1) does not limit Parts 3 or 4 of Schedule 13.

Liquidators’ remuneration

14 Remuneration of liquidators

(1) Subject to clause 22(f) of Schedule 13, every liquidator appointed under
sections 214 or 215 is entitled to charge reasonable remuneration for carrying out
his or her duties and exercising his or her powers as liquidator.
(2) Unless the Court otherwise orders, every liquidator appointed under
section 217 must charge remuneration either –
(a) Of an amount equal to the amount fixed under regulations made
under this Act; or
(b) At, or in accordance with, such rate or rates as may be prescribed
under regulations made under this Act.

15 Expenses and remuneration payable out of assets of company

The expenses and remuneration of the liquidator are payable out of the
assets of the company.
––––––––––––––––––––
556 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
SCHEDULE 15
EFFECT OF LIQUIDATION
s 211

PART 1

5

Effect on proceedings commenced before

PRELIMINARY PROVISION

commencement of liquidation

1

Company’s rules not to be altered

6

No enforcement of rights overcompany’s

property

PART 2

7

Restriction on rights of creditors to

EFFECT ON COMPANYS OFFICERS

complete execution, distraint, or

AND SHAREHOLDERS, ETC

attachment

2

Functions and powers of company’s

8

Duties of court officer in execution process

directors suspended

3 Effect on company’s shareholders PART 4

EFFECT ON CERTAIN CONDUCT

PART 3 9 Certain conduct prohibited

4 Legal proceedings not to be commenced or

continued

PART 1
PRELIMINARY PROVISION

1 Company’s rules not to be altered

With effect from the commencement of the liquidation of a company, the
rules of the company cannot be altered.
PART 2
EFFECT ON COMPANYS OFFICERS AND SHAREHOLDERS, ETC

2 Functions and powers of company’s directors suspended

With effect from the commencement of the liquidation of a company, the
directors remain in office but cease to have powers, functions, or duties other than
those required or permitted to be exercised by this Act.

3 Effect on company’s shareholders

With effect from the commencement of the liquidation of a company –
(a) Unless the Court orders otherwise, a share in the company must
not be transferred;
(b) An alteration must not be made to the rights or liabilities of a
shareholder or former shareholder of the company;
(c) A shareholder must not exercise a power under the rules of the
company or this Act, except for the purposes of this Act.
PART 3
EFFECT ON PROCEEDINGS

4 Legal proceedings not to be commenced or continued

With effect from the commencement of the liquidation of a company, a
person must not, unless the liquidator agrees or the Court orders otherwise,
commence or continue legal proceedings against the company or in relation to its
property.

5 Effect on proceedings commenced before commencement of liquidation

(1) At any time after the making of an application to the Court to appoint
a liquidator of a company and before a liquidator is appointed, the company or
any creditor or shareholder of the company may –

Companies Act 2006

557
(a) In the case of any application or proceeding against the company that is pending in the Court or Court of Appeal, apply to the Court or Court of Appeal, as the case may be, for a stay of the application or proceeding;
(b) In the case of any other application or proceeding pending against the company in any Court or tribunal, apply to the Court to restrain the application or proceeding.
(2) The Court or Court of Appeal, as the case may be, may stay or restrain the application or proceedings on any terms that it thinks fit.

6 No enforcement of rights over company’s property

(1) With effect from the commencement of the liquidation of a company, a
person must not, unless the liquidator agrees or the Court orders otherwise, exercise
or enforce, or continue to exercise or enforce, a right or remedy over or against
property of the company.
(2) Nothing in subclause (1) or in clause 4 affects the right of a secured
creditor to take possession of, realise or otherwise deal with, property of the
company over which that creditor has a charge.

7 Restriction on rights of creditors to complete execution, distraint, or attachment

(1) Subject to subclauses (2) and (3), a creditor is not entitled to retain the benefit of any execution process, distress, or attachment over or against the property of a company unless the execution process, distress, or attachment is completed before –
(a) The passing of a special resolution appointing a liquidator of the company, or the date on which the creditor had notice of the calling of a meeting at which such a resolution was proposed, whichever occurs first; or
(b) The passing of a resolution by the directors of a company appointing a liquidator of the company, or the date on which the creditor had notice of the calling of a meeting at which such a resolution was proposed, whichever occurs first; or
(c) The making of an application to the Court to appoint a liquidator of the company.
(2) Despite subclause (1) –
(a) A person who, in good faith, purchases property of a company from
a court officer charged with an execution process acquires a good
title as against the liquidator of the company;
(b) A person who, in good faith, purchases property of a company on
which distress has been levied acquires a good title as against the
liquidator of the company.
(3) The Court may set aside the application of subclause (1) to the extent
and on any conditions that the Court thinks fit.
(4) For the purposes of this clause –
(a) An execution or distraint against personal property is completed
by seizure and sale;
(b) An attachment of a debt is completed by receipt of the debt;
(c) An execution against land is completed by sale, and, in the case of
an equitable interest, by the appointment of a receiver.
(5) Nothing in this section limits or affects Part 2 of Schedule 17.
558 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

8 Duties of court officer in execution process

(1) A court officer must, on being required by a liquidator of a company to
do so, deliver or transfer the company’s property and any money received in
satisfaction or partial satisfaction of an execution or paid to avoid a sale of the
property, as the case may be, to the liquidator if –
(a) The property has been taken in an execution process; and
(b) Before completion of the execution process, the court officer charged
with the execution process receives notice that the liquidator of the
company has been appointed.
(2) The costs of the execution process are a first charge on any property or
money delivered or transferred to the liquidator under subclause (1) and the
liquidator may sell all or some of the property to satisfy that charge.
(3) The court officer must retain the proceeds of sale or the money paid for
10 working days if –
(a) Property of a company is sold in an execution process in respect of
a judgment for a sum exceeding $500; or
(b) Money is paid to the court officer charged with the execution process
to avoid a sale of the property.
(4) The court officer must deduct from the amount the costs of the execution
process and pay the balance to the liquidator if –
(a) Within the period of 10 working days, the court officer has notice
of –
(i) the calling of a meeting at which a special resolution is proposed
to appoint a liquidator; or
(ii) the calling of a meeting of the directors at which a resolution is
proposed to appoint a liquidator or of a meeting of the directors
at which the appointment of a liquidator is to be considered;
or
(iii) the making of an application to the Court to appoint a
liquidator; and
(b) The company is put into liquidation.
(5) A liquidator to whom money is paid under subclause (4) is entitled to
retain it as against the execution creditor.
(6) The Court may set aside the application of this section to the extent,
and on any conditions, that it thinks fit.
PART 4
EFFECT ON CERTAIN CONDUCT

9 Certain conduct prohibited

(1) If a company is in liquidation, or an application has been made to the
Court for an order that a company be put into liquidation, as the case may be, no
person may –
(a) Leave Niue with the intention of –
(i) avoiding payment of money due to the company; or
(ii) avoiding examination in relation to the affairs of the company;
or
(iii) avoiding compliance with an order of the Court or some other
obligation under this Part in relation to the affairs of the
company; or
(b) Conceal or remove property of the company with the intention of
preventing or delaying the liquidator taking custody or control of
it; or

Companies Act 2006

559
(c) Destroy, conceal, or remove records or other documents of the company.
(2) A person who does not comply with subclause (1) commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 250 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or both.
––––––––––––––––––––
SCHEDULE 16
LIQUIDATION COMMITTEES
ss 211, 244

PART 1

PART 2

LIQUIDATION COMMITTEE

PROCEEDINGS AT MEETINGS

1

Appointment of members

10

Frequency of meetings

2

Membership

11

Majorities

3

Powers

12

Resignation

4

Application of company’s rules

13

Office becoming vacant

5

Inability to act

14

Removal of member

6

Restriction on purchase of company’s

15

Vacancy filled

7

9

assets by liquidation committee

Members not entitled to benefit from

dealings with company’s assets

Disallowance or recovery of benefits or

16

Committee with vacancy may act

payments

PART 1
LIQUIDATION COMMITTEE

1 Appointment of members

(1) The members of a liquidation committee chosen by a meeting of
creditors or of shareholders take office immediately.
(2) The liquidator must refer the matter to the Court, and the Court may
make any decision that it thinks fit, if there is a difference between the decisions of
meetings of creditors and meetings of shareholders on –
(a) The question of appointing a liquidation committee; or
(b) The membership of a liquidation committee.

2 Membership

A liquidation committee must consist of not fewer than 3 persons who are –
(a) Creditors or shareholders; or
(b) Persons holding general powers of attorney from creditors or
shareholders; or
(c) Authorised directors or representatives of companies that are
creditors or shareholders of the company in liquidation.

3 Powers

A liquidation committee has the power to –
(a) Call for reports from the liquidator on the progress of the liquidation;
and
(b) Call a meeting of creditors or of shareholders; and
(c) Apply to the Court under Parts 3 or 4 of Schedule 13; and
(d) Assist the liquidator, as appropriate, in the conduct of the
liquidation.
560 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

4 Application of company’s rules

A meeting of shareholders called under clause 3(b) must be held in
accordance with the company’s rules (except that the liquidator has power to give
notice of a meeting of shareholders and to act as, or appoint, the chairperson of
the meeting).

5 Inability to act

If, by reason of vacancies in a liquidation committee, the committee is unable
to act, the liquidator must call attention to the situation in the next six-monthly
report required to be prepared and sent under section 247.

6 Restriction on purchase of company’s assets by liquidation committee

(1) Subject to the leave of the Court, a member of a liquidation committee
of a company must not, either directly or indirectly, become a purchaser of any
part of the company’s assets.
(2) The Court may set aside any purchase made contrary to this regulation,
and grant any consequential relief that it thinks fit.
(3) The Court may give its leave on any conditions that it thinks fit.

7 Members not entitled to benefit from dealings with company’s assets

(1) Subject to the leave of the Court, no member of a liquidation committee
may directly or indirectly be entitled to –
(a) Derive any benefit from any transaction arising out of the assets of
the company; or
(b) Receive out of the assets of the company any payment for services
rendered by him or her in connection with the administration of
the assets, or for any goods supplied by him or her to the liquidator
for, or on account of, the company; or
(c) Directly or indirectly become the purchaser of any part of the
company’s assets.
(2) If the leave of the Court is sought under subclause (1) in respect of any
payment for services, the leave may be given only if the services performed are of
a special nature and the order must specify the nature of the services for which
leave is given.

8 No remuneration

Except by the leave of the Court, no remuneration may, under any
circumstances, be paid to a member of a liquidation committee for services
rendered by him or her in the discharge of the duties attaching to his or her office
as a member of the committee.

9 Disallowance or recovery of benefits or payments

(1) The Court may disallow or recover any benefit or payment made
contrary to clauses 7 or 8.
(2) The Court may give leave under clauses 7 or 8 on any conditions that it
thinks fit.
PART 2
PROCEEDINGS AT MEETINGS

10 Frequency of meetings

(1) The committee must meet at the times as it from time to time appoints.
(2) The liquidator or a member of the committee may also call a meeting
of the committee as and when necessary.

Companies Act 2006

561

11 Majorities

The committee may act by a majority of its members present at a meeting,
but may not act unless a majority of the committee are present.

12 Resignation

A member of the committee may resign by notice in writing signed by the
member and delivered to the liquidator.

13 Office becoming vacant

The office of a member of the committee becomes vacant if the member –
(a) Becomes bankrupt; or
(b) Compounds or arranges with his or her creditors; or
(c) Is absent from 3 consecutive meetings of the committee without
the leave of those members who together with that member
represent the creditors or shareholders, as the case may be.

14 Removal of member

(1) A member of the committee may be removed by a resolution –
(a) Carried at a meeting of creditors if the member represents creditors;
or
(b) Carried at a meeting of shareholders if the member represents
shareholders.
(2) At least 5 working days’ notice of the resolution must be given, which
states the object of the meeting.

15 Vacancy filled

A vacancy in the committee may be filled by the appointment to the
committee of –
(a) A creditor or shareholder, as the case may be; or
(b) A person holding a general power of attorney from, or being an
authorised director or representative of, a company that is a creditor
or shareholder, as the case may be.

16 Committee with vacancy may act

The continuing members of the committee, if not less than 2, may act even
though a vacancy exists in the committee.
––––––––––––––––––––
562

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

SCHEDULE 17
VOIDABLE TRANSACTIONS AND CHARGES AND RECOVERIES IN OTHER CASES

S 211

13

Transactions for inadequate or excessive consideration with directors, etc

Definitions

14

Transactions for excessive consideration

15

with directors, etc

Transactions for inadequate consideration

with directors, etc

16

17

18

Court may set aside certain securities and charges

Court may set aside certain securities and charges

Certain securities exempted

Other orders, etc

19

20

Contribution for not keeping proper accounting records

Contribution for not keeping proper accounting records

When Court may not make declaration under clause 19

21

Court may require persons to repay money or return property

Court may require persons to repay money or return property

22

23

Pooling of assets

Pooling of assets of related companies

Guidelines for orders

PART 1
VOIDABLE TRANSACTIONS AND CHARGES

Voidable transactions

1 Definitions

In clause 2 –
restricted period means –
(a) The period of 6 months before the date of commencement of the
liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and
ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court,
the period of 6 months before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date on which, and at
the time at which, the order of the Court was made; and
(c) The period of 6 months before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date and at the time
of the commencement of the liquidation if –

Companies Act 2006

563
(i) an application was made to the Court to put a company into liquidation; and
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the period of 6 months before the administration begins together with the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the liquidator is appointed
specified period means –
(a) The period of 2 years before the date of commencement of the
liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and
ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court,
the period of 2 years before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date on which, and at
the time at which, the order was made; and
(c) The period of 2 years before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date and at the time
of the commencement of the liquidation if –
(i) an application was made to the Court to put a company into
liquidation; and
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator
was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the
period of 2 years before the administration begins together with
the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the
liquidator is appointed
transaction, in relation to a company, means –
(a) A conveyance or transfer of property by the company;
(b) The giving of a security or charge over the property of the company;
(c) The incurring of an obligation by the company;
(d) The acceptance by the company of execution under a judicial
proceeding;
(e) The payment of money by the company, including the payment of
money under a judgment or order of a Court.

2 Voidable transactions

(1) A transaction by a company is voidable on the application of the
liquidator if the transaction – (a) Was made –
(i) at a time when the company was unable to pay its due debts;
and
(ii) within the specified period; and
(b) Enabled another person to receive more towards satisfaction of a
debt than the person would otherwise have received or be likely to
have received in the liquidation.
(2) Subclause (1) does not apply if the transaction took place in the ordinary
course of business.
(3) Unless the contrary is proved, a transaction that took place within the
restricted period is presumed to have been made –
564

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

(a) At a time when the company was unable to pay its debts; and
(b) Otherwise than in the ordinary course of business.
(4) In determining whether a transaction took place in the ordinary course
of business, no account is, unless that other person knew that that was the intent
or purpose of the company, to be taken of any intent or purpose on the part of a
company –
(a) To enable another person to receive more towards satisfaction of a
debt than the person would otherwise receive or be likely to receive
in the liquidation; or
(b) To reduce or cancel the liability, whether in whole or in part, of
another person in respect of a debt incurred by the company; or
(c) To contribute towards the satisfaction of the liability, whether in
whole or in part, of another person in respect of a debt incurred by
the company.

3 Definitions

In clause 4 –
restricted period means –

Voidable charges

(a) The period of 6 months before the date of commencement of the liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court, the period of 6 months before the making of the application to the Court together with the period commencing on the date of the making of the application and ending on the date on which, and at the time at which, the order of the Court was made; and
(c) The period of 6 months before the making of the application to the Court together with the period commencing on the date of the making of that application and ending on the date and at the time of the commencement of the liquidation if –
(i) an application was made to the Court to put a company into
liquidation; and
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator
was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the
period of 6 months before the administration begins together with
the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the
liquidator is appointed
specified period means –
(a) The period of 1 year before the date of commencement of the
liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and
ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court,
the period of 1 year before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of the application and ending on the date on which, and at
the time at which, the order of the Court was made; and
(c) The period of 1 year before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date and at the time
of the commencement of the liquidation if –

Companies Act 2006

565
(i) an application was made to the Court to put a company into liquidation; and
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the period of 1 year before the administration begins together with the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the liquidator is appointed.

4 Voidable charges

(1) A charge over any property or undertaking of a company is voidable
on the application of the liquidator if the charge was given within the specified
period, unless –
(a) The charge secures –
(i) money actually advanced or paid; or
(ii) the actual price or value of property sold or supplied to the
company; or
(iii) any other valuable consideration given in good faith by the
grantee of the charge at the time of, or at any time after, the
giving of the charge; or
(b) Immediately after the charge was given, the company was able to
pay its due debts; or
(c) The charge is in substitution for a charge given before the specified
period.
(2) Unless the contrary is proved, a company giving a charge within the
restricted period is presumed to have been unable to pay its due debts immediately
after giving the charge.

5 Exception; certain kinds of substituted charges

Clause 4(1)(c) does not apply to the extent that –
(a) The amount secured by the substituted charge exceeds the amount
secured by the existing charge; or
(b) The value of the property subject to the substituted charge at the
date of the substitution exceeds the value of the property subject to
the existing charge at that date.

6 Exception; charge that secures unpaid purchase price

Nothing in clause 4 applies to a charge given by a company that secures
the unpaid purchase price of property, whether or not the charge is given over
that property, if –
(a) The charge document is executed not later than 30 days after the
sale of the property; or
(b) In the case of the sale of an estate or interest in land, the charge
document is executed not later than 30 days after the final settlement
of the sale.

7 Payments received by secured party

For the purposes of clauses 4(1)(a) and 6, if a charge was given by the
company within the period specified in clause 4, all payments received by the
secured party entitled to the charge after it was given are deemed to have been
appropriated so far as may be necessary –
566 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) Towards repayment of money actually advanced or paid by the secured party to the company on or after the giving of the charge; or
(b) Towards payment of the actual price or value of property sold by the secured party to the company on or after the giving of the charge; or
(c) Towards payment of any other liability of the company to the secured party in respect of any other valuable consideration given in good faith on or after the giving of the charge.

Procedure for setting aside voidable transactions and charges

8 Procedure

(1) A liquidator who wishes to have a transaction that is voidable or a
charge that is voidable set aside must –
(a) File in the Court a notice to that effect specifying the transaction or
charge to be set aside and, in the case of a transaction, the property
or value which the liquidator wishes to recover, and also the effect
of subclauses (2), (3), and (4); and
(b) Serve a copy of the notice on the other party to the transaction or
the secured creditor entitled to the charge and on every other person
from whom the liquidator wishes to recover.
(2) A person –
(a) Who would be affected by the setting aside of the transaction or
charge specified in the liquidator ’s notice; and
(b) Who considers that the transaction or charge is not voidable –
may file in the Court a notice objecting to the transaction or charge being set aside,
and serve a copy of that notice on the liquidator, within 20 working days after the
service of the liquidator ’s notice.
(3) Unless a person on whom the liquidator ’s notice was served has given
notice under subclause (2), the transaction or charge is set aside on the 20th working
day after the date of service of the notice.
(4) If 1 or more persons have given notice under subclause (2), the liquidator
may apply to the Court for an order that the transaction or charge be set aside.
That application must be served on every person referred to in paragraph (b) of
subclause (1), whether or not that person gave a notice under subclause (2).

9 Other orders

If a transaction or charge is set aside, the Court may make 1 or more of the
following orders –
(a) An order requiring a person to pay to the liquidator, in respect of
benefits received by that person as a result of the transaction or
charge, such sums as fairly represent those benefits;
(b) An order requiring property transferred as part of the transaction
to be restored to the company;
(c) An order requiring property to be vested in the company if it
represents in a person’s hands the application, either of the proceeds
of sale of property, or of money, so transferred;
(d) An order releasing, in whole or in part, a charge given by the
company;
(e) An order requiring security to be given for the discharge of an order
made under this clause;

Companies Act 2006

567
(f) An order specifying the extent to which a person affected by the setting aside of a transaction or by an order made under this clause is entitled to claim as a creditor in the liquidation.

10 Additional provisions relating to setting aside transactions and charges

(1) The setting aside of a transaction or an order made under clause 9 does
not affect the title or interest of a person in property that the person has acquired –
(a) From a person other than the company; and
(b) For valuable consideration; and
(c) Without knowledge of the circumstances under which the property
was acquired from the company.
(2) The setting aside of a charge or an order made under clause 9 does not
affect the title or interest of a person in property that the person has acquired –
(a) As the result of the exercise of a power of sale by the secured creditor
entitled to the charge; and
(b) For valuable consideration; and
(c) Without knowledge of the circumstances relating to the giving of
the charge.
(3) Recovery by the liquidator of property or its equivalent value, whether
under clause 9 or any other provision of this Act, or under any other enactment,
or in equity or otherwise, may be denied wholly or in part if –
(a) The person, from whom recovery is sought, received the property
in good faith and has altered his or her position in the reasonably
held belief that the transfer to that person was validly made and
would not be set aside; and
(b) In the opinion of the Court, it is inequitable to order recovery or
recovery in full.
(4) Nothing in the Land Act 1969 restricts the operation of this clause or
clauses 4 to 9.

11 Definitions

In clause 12 –
PART 2
RECOVERY IN OTHER CASES

Transactions at undervalue

specified period means –
(a) The period of 1 year before the date of commencement of the
liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and
ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court,
the period of 1 year before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date on which, and at
the time at which, the order of the Court was made; and
(c) The period of 1 year before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date and at the time
of the commencement of the liquidation if –
(i) an application was made to the Court to put a company into
liquidation; and
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator
was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
568 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the period of 1 year before the administration begins together with the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the liquidator is appointed
transaction includes the giving of a guarantee by a company.

12 Transactions at undervalue

(1) A liquidator of a company may recover from any other party to a
transaction any amount by which the value of the consideration or benefit provided
by the company exceeded the value of the consideration or benefit received by
the company if –
(a) The transaction was entered into by a company within the specified
period; and
(b) The value of the consideration or benefit received by the company
was less than the value of the consideration provided by the
company, or the company received no consideration or benefit; and
(c) When the transaction was entered into, the company –
(i) Was unable to pay its due debts; or
(ii) was engaged, or about to engage, in business for which its
financial resources were unreasonably small; or
(iii) incurred an obligation knowing that the company would not
be able to perform the obligation when required to do so; and
(d) When the transaction was entered into, the other party to the
transaction knew or ought to have known of the matter referred to
in paragraph (c).
(2) A liquidator of a company may recover from any other party to a
transaction any amount by which the value of the consideration or benefit provided
by the company exceeded the value of the consideration or benefit received by
the company if –
(a) The transaction was entered into by a company within the specified
period; and
(b) The value of the consideration or benefit received by the company
was less than the value of the consideration provided by the
company, or the company received no consideration or benefit; and
(c) The company became unable to pay its due debts as a result of the
transaction; and
(d) When the transaction was entered into, the other party to the
transaction knew or ought to have known that the company would
become unable to pay its due debts as a result of the transaction.

Transactions for inadequate or excessive consideration with directors, etc

13 Definitions

(1) In clause 14, specified period means –
(a) The period of 3 years before the date of commencement of the
liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and
ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court,
the period of 3 years before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of the application and ending on the date on which, and at
the time at which, the order of the Court was made; and

Companies Act 2006

569
(c) The period of 3 years before the making of the application to the Court together with the period commencing on the date of the making of that application and ending on the date and at the time of the commencement of the liquidation if –
(i) an application was made to the Court to put a company into liquidation; and
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the
period of 3 years before the administration begins together with
the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the
liquidator is appointed.
(2) For the purposes of clause 14 –
(a) The value of a business or property includes the value of any
goodwill attaching to the business or property;
(b) Without limiting the circumstances in which a company may be
taken to be controlled by a person, a company is controlled by a
person, if that person may, by exercising a power exercisable by
that person (whether with or without the consent or concurrence
of any other person), appoint or remove all the directors of the
company, or any number of directors as together hold a majority of
voting rights at a meeting of directors.

14 Transactions for excessive consideration with directors, etc

A liquidator of a company may recover from the person, relative, company,
or related company, as the case may be, any amount by which the value of the
consideration given for the acquisition of the business, property, or services
exceeded the value of the business, property, or services at the time of the
acquisition if, within the specified period, the company has acquired a business
or property from, or the services of –
(a) A person who was, at the time of the acquisition, a director of the
company, or a nominee or relative of or a trustee for, or a trustee for
a relative of, a director of the company; or
(b) A person, or a relative of a person, who, at the time of the acquisition,
had control of the company; or
(c) Another company that was, at the time of the acquisition, controlled
by a director of the company, or a nominee or relative of, or a trustee
for, or a trustee for a relative of, a director of the company; or
(d) Another company that was, at the time of the acquisition, a related
company.

15 Transactions for inadequate consideration with directors, etc

A liquidator of a company may recover from the person, relative, company,
or related company, as the case may be, any amount by which the value of the
business, property, or services, or the value of the shares, at the time of the
disposition, provision, or issue exceeded the value of any consideration received
by the company if, within the specified period, a company has disposed of a
business or property, or provided services, or issued shares, to –
(a) A person who was, at the time of the disposition, provision, or issue,
a director of the company, or a nominee or relative of or a trustee
for, or a trustee for a relative of, a director of the company; or
570 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) A person, or a relative of a person, who, at the time of the disposition, provision, or issue, had control of the company; or
(c) Another company that was, at the time of the disposition, provision, or issue, controlled by a director of the company, or a nominee or relative of or a trustee for, or a trustee for a relative of, a director of the company; or
(d) Another company that, at the time of the disposition, provision, or issue, was a related company.

Court may set aside certain securities and charges

16 Court may set aside certain securities and charges

(1) The Court may, on the application of the liquidator of a company, order
that a security or charge, or part of it, created by the company over any of its
property in favour of any of the persons referred to in subclause (2) must, so far as
any security on the property is conferred, be set aside as against the liquidator if –
(a) The company is unable to meet all its debts; and
(b) The Court considers that, having regard to the circumstances in
which the security or charge was created, the conduct of the person,
relative, company, or related company, as the case may be, in relation
to the affairs of the company, and any other relevant circumstances,
it is just and equitable to make the order.
(2) The persons referred to in subclause (1) are as follows –
(a) A person who was, at the time the security or charge was created, a
director of the company, or a nominee or relative of, or a trustee for,
or a trustee for a relative of, a director of the company; or
(b) A person, or a relative of a person, who, at the time when the security
or charge was created, had control of the company; or
(c) Another company that was, when the security or charge was
created, controlled by a director of the company, or a nominee or
relative of, or a trustee for, or a trustee for a relative of, a director of
the company; or
(d) Another company, that at the time when the security or charge was
created, was a related company.

17 Certain securities exempted

Clause 16 does not apply to a security or charge that has been transferred
by the person (person A) in whose favour it was originally created and has been
purchased by another person (whether or not from person A) if –
(a) At the time of the purchase, the purchaser was not a person specified
in that clause; and
(b) The purchase was made in good faith and for valuable
consideration.

18 Other orders, etc

(1) The Court may make any other orders that it thinks proper for the
purpose of giving effect to an order under this clause.
(2) Nothing in the Land Act 1969 restricts the operation of this clause or
clauses 16 and 17.

Companies Act 2006

571

Contribution for not keeping proper accounting records

19 Contribution for not keeping proper accounting records

(1) The Court, on the application of the liquidator, may, if it thinks it proper
to do so, declare that any 1 or more of the directors and former directors of a
company is, or are, personally responsible, without limitation of liability, for all or
any part of the debts and other liabilities of the company that the Court may
direct if –
(a) The company that is in liquidation and is unable to pay all its debts has failed to comply with –
(i) section 129 (which relates to the keeping of accounting records);
or
(ii) section 130 (which relates to the preparation of financial
statements); and
(b) The Court considers that –
(i) the failure to comply has contributed to the company’s inability
to pay all its debts, or has resulted in substantial uncertainty as
to the assets and liabilities of the company, or has substantially
impeded the orderly liquidation; or
(ii) for any other reason it is proper to make a declaration.
(2) The Court may give any direction it thinks fit for the purpose of giving
effect to the declaration.
(3) The Court may make a declaration under this clause even though the
person concerned is liable to be convicted of an offence.

20 When Court may not make declaration under clause 19

The Court must not make a declaration under clause 19 in relation to a
person if the Court considers that the person –
(a) Took all reasonable steps to secure compliance by the company with
clause 19(1)(a); or
(b) Had reasonable grounds to believe and did believe that a competent
and reliable person was charged with the duty of seeing that that
provision was complied with and was in a position to discharge
that duty.

Court may require persons to repay money or return property

21 Court may require persons to repay money or return property

(1) The Court may, on the application of the liquidator or a creditor or
shareholder, do any of the things set out in subclause (2) if, in the course of the
liquidation of a company, it appears to the Court that a person who has taken part
in the formation or promotion of the company, or a past or present director,
manager, liquidator, administrator, receiver, or officer of the company, has –
(a) Misapplied, or retained, or become liable or accountable for, money
or property of the company; or
(b) Been guilty of negligence, default, or breach of duty or trust in
relation to the company.
(2) The Court may –
(a) Inquire into the conduct of the promoter, director, manager,
liquidator, administrator, receiver, or officer; and
(b) Order that person –
(i) to repay or restore the money or property or any part of it with
interest at a rate the Court thinks just; or
572 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(ii) to contribute such sum to the assets of the company by way of compensation as the Court thinks just; or
(c) If the application is made by a creditor, order that person to pay or transfer the money or property or any part of it, with interest at a rate the Court thinks just, to the creditor.
(3) This clause has effect even though the conduct may constitute an
offence.

Pooling of assets

22 Pooling of assets of related companies

(1) On the application of the liquidator, or a creditor or shareholder, the
Court, if satisfied that it is just and equitable to do so, may order that –
(a) A company that is, or has been, related to the company in liquidation
must pay to the liquidator the whole or part of any or all of the
claims made in the liquidation;
(b) If 2 or more related companies are in liquidation, the liquidations
in respect of each company must proceed together as if they were 1
company to the extent that the Court so orders and subject to such
terms and conditions as the Court may impose.
(2) The Court may make any other order or give any directions to facilitate
giving effect to an order under subclause (1) that it thinks fit.

23 Guidelines for orders

(1) In deciding whether it is just and equitable to make an order under
clause 22(1)(a), the Court must consider the following matters –
(a) The extent to which the related company took part in the
management of the company in liquidation;
(b) The conduct of the related company towards the creditors of the
company in liquidation;
(c) The extent to which the circumstances that gave rise to the
liquidation of the company are attributable to the actions of the
related company;
(d) Any other matters as the Court thinks fit.
(2) In deciding whether it is just and equitable to make an order under
clause 22(1)(b), the Court must consider the following matters –
(a) The extent to which any of the companies took part in the
management of any of the other companies;
(b) The conduct of any of the companies towards the creditors of any
of the other companies;
(c) The extent to which the circumstances that gave rise to the
liquidation of any of the companies are attributable to the actions
of any of the other companies;
(d) The extent to which the businesses of the companies have been
combined;
(e) Any other matters that the Court thinks fit.
(3) The fact that creditors of a company in liquidation relied on the fact
that another company is, or was, related to it is not a ground for making an order
under clause 22.

Companies Act 2006

SCHEDULE 18
CREDITORS’ CLAIMS
573
s 211

PART 1

PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS

1

Admissible claims

2

Ascertainment of amount of claim

3

Claim not of ascertained amount

4

Fines and penalties

5

Claims relating to debts payable after

commencement of liquidation

6

Claims by unsecured creditors

PART 2

SECURED CLAIMS

7

Powers of secured creditors

8

Realising secured property

9

Valuation of security

10

Liquidator ’s duties on receipt of claim by

secured creditor

11

Liquidator may redeem security

12

Liquidator may require secured creditor to

exercise powers

13

Offence to make false or misleading claim

PART 3

PREFERENTIAL CLAIMS

14

Definitions

15

First priority claims

17

Third priority claims

1 Admissible claims

PART 1
PRELIMINARY PROVISIONS
(1) Subject to subclause (2), a debt or liability, present or future, certain or contingent, whether it is an ascertained debt or a liability for damages, may be admitted as a claim against a company in liquidation.
(2) Fines, monetary penalties, and costs to which clause 4 applies are not claims that may be admitted against a company in liquidation.

2 Ascertainment of amount of claim

(1) The amount of a claim must be ascertained as at the date and time of
commencement of the liquidation.
(2) The amount of a claim based on a debt or liability denominated in a
currency other than the currency of Niue must be converted into the currency of
Niue at the rate of exchange on the date of commencement of the liquidation.

3 Claim not of ascertained amount

(1) If a claim is subject to a contingency, or is for damages, or, if for some
other reason the amount of the claim is not certain, the liquidator may –
574 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(a) Make an estimate of the amount of the claim; or
(b) Refer the matter to the Court for a decision on the amount of the
claim.
(2) On the application of the liquidator, or of a claimant who is aggrieved
by an estimate made by the liquidator, the Court may determine the amount of
the claim as it thinks fit.

4 Fines and penalties

Nothing in this Act limits or affects the recovery of –
(a) A fine imposed on a company, whether before or after the
commencement of the liquidation of the company, for the
commission of an offence; or
(b) A monetary penalty payable to the Government imposed on a
company by a Court, whether before or after the commencement
of the liquidation of the company, for the breach of any enactment;
or
(c) Costs ordered to be paid by the company in relation to proceedings
for the offence or breach.

5 Claims relating to debts payable after commencement of liquidation

(1) A claim in respect of a debt that, but for the liquidation, would not be
payable until a date that is 6 months, or later than 6 months, after the date of
commencement of the liquidation is to be treated, for the purposes of this Part, as
a claim for the present value of the debt.
(2) For the purposes of subclause (1), the present value of a debt is to be
determined by deducting from the amount of the debt interest at an appropriate
rate for the period from the date on which the company is put into liquidation to
the date when the debt is due.

6 Claims by unsecured creditors

(1) A claim by an unsecured creditor against a company in liquidation must
be made in the prescribed form and must –
(a) Contain full details of the claim; and
(b) Identify any documents that evidence or substantiate the claim.
(2) The liquidator may require the production of a document referred to in
subclause (1)(b).
(3) The liquidator –
(a) Must, as soon as practicable, either admit or reject a claim in whole
or in part; and
(b) If the liquidator later considers that a claim has been wrongly
admitted or rejected in whole or in part, may revoke or amend that
decision; and
(c) Must record in writing any decision made under this subclause.
(4) If a liquidator rejects a claim, whether in whole or in part, he or she
must immediately give notice in writing of the rejection to the creditor.
(5) The costs of making a claim under subclause (1) or producing a
document under subclause (2) must be met by the creditor making the claim.
(6) Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years or to a fine not exceeding 250
penalty units, or both, if the person –
(a) Makes, or authorises the making of, a claim under this clause that
is false or misleading in a material particular knowing it to be false
or misleading; or

Companies Act 2006

575
(b) Omits, or authorises the omission, from a claim under this clause of any matter knowing that the omission makes the claim false or misleading in a material particular.
PART 2

Secured claims

7 Powers of secured creditors

(1) A secured creditor may –
(a) Realise property subject to a charge, if entitled to do so; or
(b) Value the property subject to the charge and claim in the liquidation
as an unsecured creditor for the balance due, if any; or
(c) Surrender the charge to the liquidator for the general benefit of
creditors and claim in the liquidation as an unsecured creditor for
the whole debt.
(2) A secured creditor may exercise the power referred to in subclause (1)(a)
whether or not the secured creditor has exercised the power referred to in subclause
(1)(b).

8 Realising secured property

A secured creditor who realises secured property –
(a) May, unless the liquidator has accepted a valuation and claim by
the secured creditor under clause 10, claim as an unsecured creditor
for any balance due after deducting the net amount realised;
(b) Must account to the liquidator for any surplus remaining from the
net amount realised after satisfaction of the debt, including interest
payable in respect of that debt up to the time of its satisfaction, and
after making any proper payments to the holder of any other charge
over the property subject to the charge.

9 Valuation of security

(1) If a secured creditor values the security and claims as an unsecured
creditor for the balance due, if any, the valuation and any claim must be made in
the prescribed form and –
(a) Contain full details of the valuation and any claim; and
(b) Contain full details of the charge including the date on which it
was given; and
(c) Identify any documents that substantiate the claim and the charge.
(2) The liquidator may require production of any document referred to in
subclause (1)(c).

10 Liquidator’s duties on receipt of claim by secured creditor

If a claim is made by a secured creditor under clause 9, the liquidator must –
(a) Accept the valuation and claim; or
(b) Reject the valuation and claim, in whole or in part, but –
(i) If a valuation and claim is rejected in whole or in part, the
creditor may make a revised valuation and claim within 10
working days of receiving notice of the rejection; and
(ii) the liquidator may, if he or she later considers that a valuation
and claim was wrongly rejected, in whole or in part, revoke or
amend that decision; and
(c) Record in writing any decision made by the liquidator under this
clause.
576 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

11 Liquidator may redeem security

The liquidator may, unless the secured creditor has realised the property,
at any time, redeem the security on payment of the assessed value if the liquidator –
(a) Accepts a valuation and claim under clause 10(a); or
(b) Accepts a revised valuation and claim under clause 10(b)(i); or
(c) Accepts a valuation and claim on revoking or amending a decision
to reject a claim under clause 10(b)(ii).

12 Liquidator may require secured creditor to exercise powers

(1) The liquidator may at any time, by notice in writing, require a secured
creditor, within 20 working days after receipt of the notice, to –
(a) Elect which of the powers referred to in clause 7 the creditor wishes
to exercise; and
(b) If the creditor elects to exercise the power referred to in clause 7(1)(b)
or (c), exercise the power within that period.
(2) A secured creditor on whom notice has been served under subclause
(1) who fails to comply with the notice, is to be taken as having surrendered the
charge to the liquidator under clause 7(1)(c) for the general benefit of creditors,
and may claim in the liquidation as an unsecured creditor for the whole debt.
(3) A secured creditor who has surrendered a charge under clause 7(1)(c)
or who is taken as having surrendered a charge under subclause (2) may, with the
leave of the Court or the liquidator and subject to any conditions that the Court or
the liquidator thinks fit, at any time before the liquidator has realised the property
charged –
(a) Withdraw the surrender and rely on the charge; or
(b) Submit a new claim under this clause.

13 Offence to make false or misleading claim

Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years or to a fine not exceeding 1000
penalty units, or both if the person –
(a) Makes, or authorises the making of, a claim under clause 9 that is
false or misleading in a material particular knowing it to be false or
misleading; or
(b) Omits, or authorises the omission, from a claim under that clause
of any matter knowing that the omission makes the claim false or
misleading in a material particular.

14 Definitions

PART 3
PREFERENTIAL CLAIMS
For the purposes of this Part –
remuneration in respect of a period of holiday or of absence from work
through
sickness or other good cause must be treated as wages in respect of services
rendered to the company during that period
paid annual leave, in relation to a person, means all sums payable
to that person by the company that by or under any Act or any award,
agreement, or contract of service are payable to that person by the
company as holiday pay.

Companies Act 2006

577

15 First priority claims

The liquidator must first pay, in the order of priority in which they are
listed –
(a) The fees and expenses properly incurred by the liquidator in carrying out the duties and exercising the powers of the liquidator and the remuneration of the liquidator;
(b) The reasonable costs of a person who applied to the Court for an order that the company be put into liquidation, including the reasonable costs of a person appearing on the application whose costs are allowed by the Court;
(c) The actual out-of-pocket expenses necessarily incurred by a liquidation committee.

16 Second priority claims

(1) After paying the claims referred to in clause 15, the liquidator must
next pay the following claims;

Employees’ wages or salary

(a) Subject to subclause (2), all wages or salary of any employee,
whether or not earned wholly or in part by way of commission,
and whether payable for time or for piece work, in respect of services
rendered to the company during the 4 months before the
commencement of the liquidation;

Employees’ annual leave

(b) Subject to subclause (2), paid annual leave becoming payable to an
employee (or if the employee has died, to any other person in the
employee’s right) on the termination of the employment before or
by reason of the commencement of the liquidation;

Accident compensation

(c) Amounts due in respect of any compensation or liability for
compensation payable to an employee or to the dependents of an
employee that accrued before the commencement of the liquidation;

Amounts deducted by company from employees’ wages or salary

(d) Subject to subclause (2), amounts deducted by the company from
the wages or salary of an employee in order to satisfy obligations
of the employee;

Preferential claims under section 234

(e) Amounts that are preferential claims under section 234(2);

Superannuation contributions

(f) Any contributions payable by the company to a superannuation
scheme of an employee;

Priority payments under other enactments

(g) All sums that by any other enactment are required to be paid in
accordance with the priority established by this clause;
578 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Workers’ compensation

(h) Unless the company is being liquidated merely for the purposes of
reconstruction or of amalgamation with another company, or unless
the company has at the commencement of the liquidation under
such a contract of insurance rights capable of being transferred to
and vested in the worker, all amounts due in respect of any workers
compensation or liability for workers compensation accrued before
the relevant date.
(2) The total sum to which priority is to be given under subclause (1)(a),
(b), (d), (e), or (f) must not, in the case of any 1 employee, exceed $3,000 or any
greater amount that is prescribed at the commencement of the liquidation.
(3) If a payment has been made to the following persons out of money
advanced by some person for that purpose, the person by whom the money was
advanced has, in a liquidation, the same right of priority in respect of the money
advanced as the employee, or other person receiving the payment in right of the
employee, would have if the payment had not been made –
(a) An employee of a company on account of wages or salary;
(b) Any such employee or, if the employee has died, to any other person
in the employee’s right, on account of holiday pay.

17 Third priority claims

After paying the sums referred to in clause 16, the liquidator must next pay
the following to the extent that the amount is for the time being unpaid to the
Financial Secretary or to the Collector of Customs, as the case may require;

Income tax

(a) Tax payable by the company;

Tax deductions

(b) Tax deductions made by the company in respect of the earnings of
employees of the company;

Non-resident withholding tax,

(c) Tax deducted by a company on behalf of an agent, absentee or non­
resident;

Customs and excise duty

(d) Duty payable within the meaning of the Customs Act 1966.

18 Ranking of claims in clauses 16 and 17

(1) The claims listed in each of clauses 16 and 17 –
(a) Rank equally among themselves and must be paid in full, unless
the assets are insufficient to meet them, in which case they abate in
equal proportions; and
(b) So far as the assets of the company available for payment of general
creditors are insufficient to meet them, have priority over the claims
of persons in respect of assets that are subject to a floating charge
and must be paid accordingly out of those assets.
(2) To the extent that the claims to which subclause (1) applies are paid out
of assets referred to in paragraph (b) of that subclause, the amount so paid is an
unsecured debt due by the company to the secured party.

Companies Act 2006

579

19 When landlord or other person has distrained on goods, etc

If a landlord or other person has distrained on goods or effects of the
company within the month before the commencement of the liquidation –
(a) The claims to which priority is given by this Part are a first charge
on the goods or effects so distrained on, or the proceeds from their
sale; but
(b) If any money is paid to a claimant under any such charge, the
landlord or other person has the same rights of priority as that
claimant.

20 Definitions

In this Part –
PART 4
MUTUAL CREDIT AND SET-OFF
related person includes a related company and includes a director of the company in liquidation
restricted period means –
(a) The period of 2 years before the date of commencement of the
liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and
ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court,
the period of 2 years before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date on which, and at
the time at which, the order of the Court was made; and
(c) The period of 2 years before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of an application and ending on the date and at the time of
the commencement of the liquidation if –
(i) the application was made to the Court to put a company into
liquidation; and
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator
was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the
period of 6 months before the administration begins together with
the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the
liquidator is appointed
specified period means –
(a) the period of 6 months before the date of commencement of the
liquidation together with the period commencing on that date and
ending at the time at which the liquidator is appointed; and
(b) In the case of a company that was put into liquidation by the Court,
the period of 6 months before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of that application and ending on the date on which, and at
the time at which, the order of the Court was made; and
(c) The period of 6 months before the making of the application to the
Court together with the period commencing on the date of the
making of an application and ending on the date and at the time of
the commencement of the liquidation if –
(i) the application was made to the Court to put a company into
liquidation; and
580 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(ii) after the making of the application to the Court a liquidator was appointed under sections 214 or 215; and
(d) In the case of a liquidator appointed under section 188(1)(c), the period of 6 months before the administration begins together with the period commencing on that date and ending at the time the liquidator is appointed.

21 Mutual credit and set-off

If there have been mutual credits, mutual debts, or other mutual dealings
between a company and a person who seeks or, but for the operation of this clause,
would seek to have a claim admitted in the liquidation of the company –
(a) An account must be taken of what is due from the one party to the
other in respect of those credits, debts, or dealings; and
(b) An amount due from one party must be set off against an amount
due from the other party; and
(c) Only the balance of the account may be claimed in the liquidation,
or is payable to the company, as the case may be.

22 Proof for person who is not related person

Unless the person proves that, at the time of the transaction or assignment,
the person did not have reason to suspect that the company was unable to pay its
debts as they became due, a person who is not a related person is not entitled to
claim the benefit of a set-off arising from –
(a) A transaction made within the specified period, being a transaction
by which the person gave credit to the company or the company
gave credit to the person; or
(b) The assignment within the specified period to that person of a debt
owed by the company to another person.

23 Proof for person who is related person

Unless the related person proves that, at the time of the transaction or
assignment, the related person did not have reason to suspect that the company
was unable to pay its debts as they became due, the related person is not entitled
to claim the benefit of a set-off arising from –
(a) A transaction made within the restricted period, being a transaction
by which the related person gave credit to the company or the
company gave credit to the related person; or
(b) The assignment within the restricted period to that person of a debt
owed by the company to another person.

24 Exception for amounts paid or payable by shareholder

Clauses 21 to 23 do not apply to an amount paid or payable by a shareholder
or former shareholder –
(a) As the consideration, or part of the consideration, for the issue of a
share; or
(b) In satisfaction of a call in respect of an outstanding liability of the
shareholder made by the directors or by the liquidator.

Companies Act 2006

PART 5
MISCELLANEOUS
581

25 Interest on claims

(1) The amount of a claim may include interest up to the date of
commencement of the liquidation –
(a) At such rate as may be specified or contained in any contract that
makes provision for the payment of interest on that amount; or
(b) In the case of a judgment debt, at such rate as is payable on the
judgment debt.
(2) If any surplus assets remain after the payment of all admitted claims,
interest must be paid at the prescribed rate on those claims from the date of
commencement of the liquidation to the date on which each claim is paid, and if
the amount of the surplus assets is insufficient to pay interest in full on all claims,
payment must abate rateably among all claims.
(3) If any surplus assets remain after the payment of interest in accordance
with subclause (2), interest must be paid on all admitted claims referred to in
subclause (1) from the date of commencement of the liquidation to the date on
which the claim is paid at a rate equal to the excess between the prescribed rate
and the rate referred to in subclause (1)(a), as the case may be, and, if the amount
of the surplus assets is insufficient to pay interest in full on all claims, payment
must abate rateably among all claims.
(4) For the purposes of this clause, prescribed rate means the rate prescribed
in regulations made under this Act or, if no such rate is prescribed, the rate at
which interest is payable on money due under a judgment of the Court.

26 Trade discounts

A creditor making his or her claim must deduct all trade discounts that he
or she would otherwise have given if the company had not gone into liquidation.

27 Periodical payments

(1) When any payment (including rent) falls due at stated periods, and
liquidation commences at any time other than at the beginning of 1 of those periods,
the persons entitled to the payment may claim up to the date of commencement
of liquidation as if the payment accrued on a daily basis.
(2) Nothing in subclause (1) affects the right of the lessor of the property
to claim rent that accrues on or after the commencement of liquidation.

28 Employees’ claims

(1) A person may make a claim on behalf of all or a number of employees
of the company.
(2) A schedule setting out the names of the employees, and the amounts
due to each of them, must be attached to the claim.
(3) Any claim made in compliance with this regulation has the same effect
as if separate claims had been made by each of the employees.
582 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

29 Notice to creditors to claim

(1) Subject to the provisions of the Act, and unless otherwise ordered by
the Court, the liquidator may fix a certain day, which must not be less than 10
working days from the date of the notice, on or before which the creditors of the
company are to make their claims, and to establish any priority their claims may
have under Part 3.
(2) The liquidator must give public notice of the day fixed in accordance
with subclause (1).

30 Failure to claim by day fixed for claims

(1) Subject to subclause (2), any creditor who fails to make a claim on or
before the day fixed in accordance with clause 29 will be excluded from the benefit
of any distribution made before his or her claim is made.
(2) A creditor who makes a claim after the day fixed in accordance with
clause 29 and whose claim is admitted is entitled to receive the benefit of any
distribution from which the creditor was previously excluded if any assets remain,
or, in the opinion of the liquidator, are likely to remain, available for distribution.

31 Failure to establish priority by day fixed for claims

(1) Subject to subclause (2), any creditor who fails to establish any priority
that the creditor ’s claim may have on or before the day fixed in accordance with
clause 29 must be excluded from objecting to any distribution made before the
priority of that claim is established.
(2) The liquidator may, in making any distribution after the claim is
admitted, make an assumption as to the priority that the claim may have and
accord the creditor the benefit of the distribution accordingly.
(3) A creditor who establishes the priority of the creditor ’s claim after the
day fixed in accordance with clause 29 is entitled to receive the benefit of any
distribution from which the creditor was previously excluded (if any) if any assets
remain, or, in the opinion of the liquidator, are likely to remain, available for
distribution.

32 Dividends in respect of rejected claims

(1) If any creditor applies to the Court for an order reversing or modifying
the decision of a liquidator to reject the creditor ’s claim, the liquidator may in any
such case make provision for the dividend on the claim, and the probable cost of
the application in the event of the claim being admitted.
(2) If no notice of an application has been given within the time specified
in this Act or in regulations made under this Act for appeals to the Court from a
decision of the liquidator, the liquidator must exclude all claims that have been
rejected from participation in the dividend.

33 Costs of proceedings relating to liquidator’s decision on claim

If any creditor applies to the Court for an order reversing or modifying the
decision of a liquidator to reject the creditor ’s claim, the Court may, if it thinks
fit –
(a) Allow any costs of any creditor to be added to the creditor ’s claim;
(b) Allow any costs of any party to be paid out of the assets of the
company, such costs being deemed to be expenses of the liquidator;
(c) Order any costs to be paid by any party to the proceedings other
than the liquidator.
–––––––––––––––––––

Companies Act 2006

SCHEDULE 19
LIQUIDATION OF ASSETS OF OVERSEAS COMPANIES
583
s 290(1)

1 Modified application of subpart 3 of Part 9

Subpart 3 of Part 9 applies to the liquidation of the assets in Niue of an
overseas company, with the following modifications and exclusions –
(a) References to assets are to be taken as references to assets in Niue;
(b) References to a company are to be taken as references to an overseas
company;
(c) References to removal from the Niue register are to be taken as
references to ceasing to carry on business in Niue;
(d) The following provisions do not apply to such a liquidation;
(i) clause 6 of Schedule 13;
(ii) clauses 1 and 3 of Schedule 15;
(e) Clause 2 of Schedule 15 does not affect the tenure of directors of an
overseas company, but the overseas company and its directors cease
to have any powers, functions, or duties in relation to the company’s
assets in Niue, other than those required or permitted to be exercised
by subpart 3 of Part 9;
(f) Section 252 applies to such a liquidation, but instead of making the
statement required by subsection (1)(b)(iii) of that section, the
liquidator must state that the company has ceased to carry on
business in Niue and is ready to be removed from the overseas
register.

2 Rights of action not affected

Nothing in this Act excludes the right of a creditor of an overseas company
in relation to the assets of which a liquidator has been appointed –
(a) To bring proceedings outside Niue against the overseas company
in relation to a debt not claimed in the liquidation or the balance of
a debt remaining unpaid after the completion of a liquidation; or
(b) To bring an action in Niue in relation to the balance of a debt
remaining unpaid after the completion of a liquidation.
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 20
[Spent]
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 21
[Spent]

584 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

Niue Laws (Volume 2)

NIUE LAWS

TAU FAKATUFONO-TOHI A NIUE

LEGISLATION AS AT DECEMBER 2006

VOLUME 2 TOHI 2

STATUTES

CONSTITUTIONAL – M

GOVERNMENT OF NIUE, ALOFI

2006

Copyright 2006 All rights reserved

Enquiries concerning the copyright material

should be addressed to the

Crown Law Office, Alofi, Niue

Printed by Stylex Print, Palmerston North, New Zealand

VOLUME TWO

Constitutional Polls Act 1977 .................................................................................. 585
Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971 ..................................................... 587
Continental Shelf Act 1964 ...................................................................................... 613
Crimes against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages Act 1984 ...... 617
Crown Proceedings Act 1950 .................................................................................. 625
Customs Act 1966 ..................................................................................................... 641
Customs Tariff Act 1982 ........................................................................................... 717
Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952 ...................................................... 719
Departure Tax Act 1996 ............................................................................................ 727
Development Investment Act 1992 ........................................................................ 729
Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968 .................................................. 743
Dogs Act 1966 ............................................................................................................ 761
Domestic Fishing Act 1995 ...................................................................................... 769
Education Act 1989 ................................................................................................... 777
Electric Power Supply Act 1960 .............................................................................. 793
Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985 ............................................................. 799
Environment Act 2003 .............................................................................................. 809
Extradition Act 1965 ................................................................................................. 821
Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979 ............................................................... 823
Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006 ........................................................... 837
Fireworks Act 1958 ................................................................................................... 859
Food Control Act 1981 .............................................................................................. 861
Fugitive Offenders Act 1881 .................................................................................... 869
General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade Act 1948 .............................................. 871
General Laws Act 1968 ............................................................................................. 873
Geneva Conventions Act 1958 ................................................................................ 877
Government Loans Act 1980 ................................................................................... 885
Guardianship Act 1968 ............................................................................................. 891
Income Tax Act 1961 ................................................................................................. 901
Incorporated Societies Act 1908 .............................................................................. 965
Inquest Act 1964 ........................................................................................................ 977
International Finance Agreements Act 1961 ......................................................... 989
International Finance Agreements Amendment Act 1966 .................................. 995
Interpretation Act 2004 ............................................................................................. 999
Land Act 1969 .......................................................................................................... 1009
Liquor Act 1975 ....................................................................................................... 1025
Manufactured Goods Tax Act 1964 ...................................................................... 1031
Marine Insurance Act 1908 .................................................................................... 1035
Mercantile Law Act 1908 ....................................................................................... 1059
Merchandise Marks Act 1954 ................................................................................ 1073
Mining Act 1977 ...................................................................................................... 1085
Minors’ Contracts Act 1969 ................................................................................... 1097
Misuse of Drugs Act 1975 ...................................................................................... 1103
Mosquito Control Act 1980 .................................................................................... 1105
Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998 ............................................... 1107
585

CONSTITUTIONAL POLLS ACT 1977

1977/28 – 14 April 1977

1

Short title

5

Declaration of result of poll and

2

Special poll of electors as to Bills to which

communication to the Speaker

article 35 of the Niue Constitution applies

6

Regulations

3

Application of provisions of Assembly Act

4

Electoral rolls

SCHEDULE

To provide for special polls relating to proposed amendments to the Niue

Constitution Act 1974 or the Niue Constitution

1 Short title

This is the Constitutional Polls Act 1977.

2 Special poll of electors as to Bills to which article 35 of the Niue

Constitution applies

(1) Whenever a Bill to which article 35 of the Niue Constitution applies,
has satisfied the requirements of article 35 (1) (a), there shall be taken within the
meaning of the Assembly Act 1966, a poll on the question whether the proposal in
the Bill is supported or not supported.
(2) The poll shall be taken on a day to be fixed by the Speaker by notice in
the Gazette or in a newspaper circulating in Niue and shall be a poll of the electors
of the several village constituencies who are entitled to vote at a general election
of members of the Niue Assembly.
(3) The question shall be submitted in the form in the Schedule.

3 Application of provisions of the Assembly Act

Subject to this Act and any regulations made under it, and subject to all
necessary modifications, the poll shall be taken in the same manner as if it were a
general election of members of the Niue Assembly and the Assembly Act 1966
and any other law relating to such elections, as far as they are applicable, shall
apply accordingly.

4 Electoral rolls

(1) Subject to this section, the electoral roll for each village constituency at
the poll shall be the roll as provided by the Assembly Act 1966.
(2) The electoral roll in each village constituency shall close 10 days before
the date fixed for the taking of the poll.
(3) The electoral rolls to be used in each village constituency shall be the
main and supplementary rolls used at the last general election, together with a
further supplementary roll to be prepared by the Chief Electoral Officer and to
include the names of all electors registered by him after the closing of the rolls for
the last general election and remaining on the roll for each village constituency at
its closing under subsection (2).
586 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

5 Declaration of result of poll and communication to Speaker

(1) After the close of the poll in each village constituency the Presiding
Officer shall count the votes recorded for and against the proposal and shall reject
all informal votes.
(2) Immediately after he has counted the votes he shall send to the Chief
Electoral Officer a statement of the number of informal votes, and of the total
number of valid votes recorded, and of the number of valid votes recorded for
and against the proposal.
(3) On receipt of the statement from all Presiding Officers, the Chief
Electoral Officer shall conduct the final count and declare –
(a) The total number of valid votes recorded at the poll throughout
Niue and in each village constituency for the proposal; and
(b) The total number of valid votes recorded at the poll throughout
Niue and in each village constituency against the proposals.
(c) The total number of votes rejected as informal.
(4) The Chief Electoral Officer shall communicate to the Speaker and shall
notify in the Gazette or in a newspaper circulating in Niue, the numbers of the
votes as finally ascertained by him in respect of the whole of Niue and in respect
of each village constituency, and the result of the poll as determined thereby in
respect of the whole of Niue.

6 Regulations

The Cabinet may make regulations for any purpose for which regulations
are required or contemplated by this Act.

SCHEDULE

VOTING PAPER – Section 2 (3)

Constitutional Amendment Poll

(article 35 Niue Constitution)

Consecutive Number

................................................................................. Village Constituency

DO YOU VOTE IN FAVOUR OF THE .......................................................................... BILL? YES ...........................

or

NO ............................

DIRECTIONS TO VOTER

1 Place a tick () by the answer you wish to give.

2 After voting, fold this paper and place it in the ballot box.

3 You must not take this paper outside the polling booth.

4 If you spoil this paper, return it to the Poll Clerk and obtain another.

587

CONSULAR PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES ACT 1971

1971/11 (NZ) – 1 April 1972

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

Short title Interpretation [Spent]

Consular privileges and immunities Immunities of certain employees of a consular post

Withdrawal of consular privileges and immunities

Immunities of certain persons in service of Commonwealth or foreign countries

8

9

10

11

12-14

Refunds or payments where fiscal privileges accorded

Certificate of the Cabinet

[Spent]

Regulations

[Spent]

SCHEDULE

To make provision with respect to consular privileges and immunities, and to give effect to the Vienna Convention on Consular Relations

1 Short title

This is the Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
(a) “Convention” means the Vienna Convention on Consular Relations
signed in 1863, a copy of the English text of which is set out in
Schedule 1;
(b) Expressions defined in article 1 of the Convention have the
meanings so defined.

3 [Spent]

4 Consular privileges and immunities

(1) Subject to subsection (7) the following provisions of the Convention
shall have the force of law in Niue, namely:
(a) Articles 1, 5 and 15, article 17 (1), article 31 (1), (2), (4) and article 32,
33, 35 and 39, article 41 (1), (2), articles 43 to 45 and 48 to 54, article
55 (2) and (3), article 57 (2), articles 60 to 62, 66 and 67, and article 70
(1), (2) and (4);
(b) Article 58 (1), (2) and (3) except in relation to any articles referred to
therein that do not have the force of law in Niue under paragraph
(a);
588 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(c) Article 71, except in relation to article 42.
(2) Subject to subsection (1), Cabinet may determine, either generally or in
any case or class of case, the fiscal privileges which shall be accorded to any consular
post or persons connected with any consular post, notwithstanding that the
determination may extend treatment more favourable than that required by the
provisions of the Convention, and may in like manner determine the terms and
conditions on which those privileges may be enjoyed.
(3) (a) For the purpose of giving effect to any custom or agreement by
which Niue and any other State extend to each other treatment more
favourable than is required by the provisions of the Convention,
Cabinet may, by regulation, declare that a consular post of that State
and persons connected with that consular post shall be accorded
such immunity from jurisdiction, and inviolability, as are specified
in the order.
(b) Nothing in this subsection shall apply with respect to persons to
whom section 5 applies.
(4) In subsection (2) “persons connected with any consular post” includes
any person in respect of whom a regulation has been made for the purposes of
section 7.
(5) In subsections (2) and (3) “treatment more favourable” includes the
according of privileges or immunities, as the case may be, to persons who under
the Convention may enjoy privileges and immunities only if and so far as these
are granted to them by the receiving State.
(6) Where by virtue of this Act any immunity from jurisdiction is accorded
to persons who do not enjoy immunity under the Convention, that immunity
may be waived in the manner and subject to the conditions specified in article 45
of the Convention, and the waiver shall have the same consequences as a waiver
under that article.
(7) For the purposes of the articles referred to in subsection (1) –
(a) A reference to the receiving State shall be construed as a reference
to Niue;
(b) A reference to a national of the receiving State shall be construed as
a reference to a New Zealand citizen;
(c) The reference in article 31 (2) to authorities of the receiving State
shall be construed as including a reference to any constable and
any person exercising a power of entry to premises;
(d) The reference in article 41 (1) to a grave crime shall be construed as
a reference to any offence punishable with imprisonment for a term
of 3 years or more or for life;
(e) The reference in article 44 (3) to matters connected with the exercise
of the functions of members of a consular post shall be construed
as references to matters connected with the exercise of consular
functions by consular officers or consular employees;
(f) The reference in article 45 to waiver by the sending State shall be
construed as including a reference to a waiver by the head, or by a
person for the time being performing the functions of head, of the
diplomatic mission of the sending State or, if there is no such
mission, of the consular post concerned;
(g) Articles 50 to 52, 54, 62 and 67 shall be construed as granting the
privileges or immunities that those articles require to be granted;
(h) The reference in article 50 (1) and in article 62 to such laws and
regulations as the receiving State may adopt shall be construed as

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

589
including a reference to any law in force in Niue relating to the quarantine, or the prohibition or restriction of the importation into, or the exportation from Niue of animals, plants or goods, but any immunity from jurisdiction that a person may possess or enjoy by virtue of subsection (1) shall not be prejudiced;
(i) The reference in article 57 (2) to the privileges and immunities
provided in chapter 2 shall be construed as a reference to those
provided in section 2 of that Chapter;
(j) The reference in article 70 (4) to the rules of international law
concerning diplomatic relations shall be construed as a reference to
Part 1 of the Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968;
(k) The reference in article 71 (1) to any additional privileges and
immunities that may be granted by the receiving State, and the
reference in article 71 (2) to privileges and immunities so far as these
are granted by the receiving State, shall, so far as they relate to fiscal
privileges, be construed as references to such determinations as may
be made by Cabinet under subsection (2) and, so far as they relate
to immunities, be construed as references to such immunities as
may be conferred by a regulation under subsection (3).

5 Immunities of certain employees of a consular post

Consular employees of a consular post headed by a career consular officer
who are New Zealand citizens or are permanently resident in Niue shall be
accorded immunity from jurisdiction in respect of all official acts performed in
the exercise of their functions.

6 Withdrawal of consular privileges and immunities

Where Cabinet is satisfied that the privileges and immunities accorded in
relation to a consular post of Niue in any State, or to persons connected with that
consular post, are less than those conferred by or by virtue or this Act in relation
to a consular post of that State, or to persons connected with any such consular
post, Cabinet may, by regulation, withdraw, modify, or restrict, in relation to that
consular post or to persons connected with that consular post, such of the privileges
and immunities so conferred to such extent as appears to him to be proper.

7 Immunities of certain persons in service of Commonwealth or foreign countries

(1) Cabinet may, by regulation, confer on –
(a) Persons in the service of the Government of any country; and
(b) Persons in the service of the Government of any territory for whose
international relations the Government of any Commonwealth
country is responsible –
performing functions corresponding to those of a consular officer or consular
employee, and holding such offices or classes of offices as are specified in the
regulation, such immunity from jurisdiction and such inviolability, as are specified
in the regulation.
(2) Cabinet may, by regulation declare that the provisions of this Act shall
apply, to such extent as may be specified in the regulation, to persons appointed
by the Government of any other Commonwealth country to serve as consular
officers or consular employees in Niue.
(3) Any regulation made under this section may accord, to such extent as
may be specified in the regulation, inviolability to the official premises and official
590 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
archives of any person in respect of whom a regulation has been made for the purposes of this section.

8 Refunds or payments where fiscal privileges accorded

(1) Cabinet may direct that such refunds or payments be made from any
public fund or account or from the money of any local authority, public body, or
person as may in the opinion of Cabinet be necessary to give effect to any fiscal
privilege accorded under section 4.
(2) Where any loss is suffered by any public fund or account other than
the Niue Government by reason of the conferring of any such privilege or by the
making of any refund or payment directed under this section, the Cabinet may
direct that such payments be made from the Niue Government Account to that
other fund or account as may be necessary in the opinion of Cabinet to reimburse
that loss.
(3) Where any loss is suffered by any local authority, public body, or person
by reason of the conferring of any such privilege or by the making of any refund
or payment directed under this section, the Cabinet may direct that such payments
be made from the Niue Government Account to that local authority, public body,
or person as may be necessary in the opinion of Cabinet to reimburse that loss.
(4) All refunds or payments directed under this section to be made from
any public fund or account shall be made without further appropriation than this
section.

9 Certificate of the Cabinet

If in any proceedings any question arises whether or not any person is or
was at any time or in respect of any period accorded any privilege or immunity
under or by virtue of this Act, a certificate issued by the Cabinet stating any fact
relevant to that question shall be conclusive evidence of that fact.

10 [Spent]

11 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations providing for such matters as are
contemplated by or necessary for giving full effect to this Act and for the due
administration of it.

12-14 [Spent]

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

SCHEDULE

Section 2

VIENNA CONVENTION ON CONSULAR RELATIONS THE STATES PARTIES TO THE PRESENT CONVENTION,
591
RECALLING that consular relations have been established between peoples since ancient times,
HAVING IN MIND the Purposes and Principles of the Charter of the United Nations concerning the sovereign equality of States, the maintenance of international peace and security, and the promotion of friendly relations among nations,
CONSIDERING that the United Nations Conference on Diplomatic Intercourse and Immunities adopted the Vienna Convention on Diplomatic Relations which was opened for signature on April 18, 1961,
BELIEVING that an international convention on consular relations, privileges and immunities would also contribute to the development of friendly relations among nations, irrespective of their differing constitutional and social systems, REALIZING that the purpose of such privileges and immunities is not to benefit individuals but to ensure the efficient performance of functions by consular posts on behalf of their respective States,
AFFIRMING that the rules of customary international law continue to govern matters not expressly regulated by the provisions of the present Convention, HAVE AGREED as follows:
ARTICLE 1

Definitions

1. For the purposes of the present Convention, the following expressions
shall have the meanings hereunder assigned to them:
(a) “consular post” means any consulate-general, consulate, vice-
consulate or consular agency;
(b) “consular district” means the area assigned to a consular post for
the exercise of consular functions;
(c) “head of consular post” means the person charged with the duty of
acting in that capacity;
(d) “consular officer” means any person, including the head of a
consular post, entrusted in that capacity with the exercise of consular
functions;
(e) “consular employee” means any person employed in the
administrative or technical service of a consular post;
(f) “member of the service staff” means any person employed in the
domestic service of a consular post;
(g) “members of the consular post” means consular officers, consular
employees and members of the service staff;
(h) “members of the consular staff” means consular officers, other than
the head of a consular post, consular employees and members of
the service staff;
(i) “member of the private staff” means a person who is employed
exclusively in the private service of a member of the consular post;
(j) “consular premises” means the buildings or parts of buildings and
the land ancillary thereto, irrespective of ownership, used
exclusively for the purposes of the consular post;
592 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(k) “consular archives” includes all the papers, documents, correspondence, books, films, tapes and registers of the consular post, together with the ciphers and codes, the card-indexes and any article of furniture intended for their protection or safekeeping.
2 Consular officers are of two categories, namely career consular officers and honorary consular officers. The provisions of Chapter II of the present Convention apply to consular posts headed by career consular officers; the provisions of Chapter III govern consular posts headed by honorary consular officers.
3 The particular status of members of the consular posts who are nationals or permanent residents of the receiving State is governed by Article 71 of the present Convention.
CHAPTER 1 – CONSULAR RELATIONS IN GENERAL SECTION 1 – ESTABLISHMENT AND CONDUCT OF CONSULAR
RELATIONS
ARTICLE 2

Establishment of consular relations

1. The establishment of consular relations between States takes place by
mutual consent.
2. The consent given to the establishment of diplomatic relations between
two States implies, unless otherwise stated, consent to the establishment of consular
relations.
3. The severance of diplomatic relations shall not ipso facto involve the
severance of consular relations.
ARTICLE 3

Exercise of consular functions

Consular functions are exercised by consular posts. They are also exercised by
diplomatic missions in accordance with the provisions of the present Convention.
ARTICLE 4

Establishment of a consular post

1. A consular post may be established in the territory of the receiving
State only with that State’s consent.
2. The seat of the consular post, its classification and the consular district
shall be established by the sending State and shall be subject to the approval of
the receiving State.
3. Subsequent changes in the seat of the consular post, its classification or
the consular district may be made by the sending State only with the consent of
the receiving State.
4. The consent of the receiving State shall also be required if a consulate-
general or a consulate desires to open a vice-consulate or a consular agency in a
locality other than that in which it is itself established.
5. The prior express consent of the receiving State shall also be required
for the opening of an office forming part of an existing consular post elsewhere
than at the seat thereof.

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

593
Consular functions consist in:
ARTICLE 5

Consular functions

(a) Protecting in the receiving State the interests of the sending State and of its nationals, both individuals and bodies corporate, within the limits permitted by international law;
(b) Furthering the development of commercial, economic, cultural and scientific relations between the sending State and the receiving State and otherwise promoting friendly relations between them in accordance with the provisions of the present Convention;
(c) Ascertaining by all lawful means conditions and developments in the commercial, economic, cultural and scientific life of the receiving State, reporting thereon to the Government of the sending State and giving information to persons interested;
(d) Issuing passports and travel documents to nationals of the sending
State, and visas or appropriate documents to persons wishing to
travel to the sending State;
(e) Helping and assisting nationals, both individuals and bodies
corporate, of the sending State;
(f) Acting as notary and civil registrar and in capacities of a similar
kind, and performing certain functions of an administrative nature,
provided that there is nothing contrary thereto in the laws and
regulations of the receiving State;
(g) Safeguarding the interests of nationals, both individuals and bodies
corporate, of the sending State in cases of succession mortis causa in
the territory of the receiving State, in accordance with the laws and
regulations of the receiving State;
(h) Safeguarding, within the limits imposed by the laws and regulations
of the receiving State, the interests of minors and other persons
lacking full capacity who are nationals of the sending State,
particularly where any guardianship or trusteeship is required with
respect to such persons;
(i) Subject to the practices and procedures obtaining in the receiving
State, representing or arranging appropriate representation for
nationals of the sending State before the tribunals and other
authorities of the receiving State, for the purpose of obtaining, in
accordance with the laws and regulations of the receiving State,
provisional measures for the preservation of the rights and interests
of these nationals, where, because of absence or any other reason,
such nationals are unable at the proper time to assume the defence
of their rights and interests;
(j) Transmitting judicial and extra-judicial documents or executing
letters rogatory or commissions to take evidence for the courts of
the sending State in accordance with international agreements in
force or, in the absence of such international agreements, in any
other manner compatible with the laws and regulations of the
receiving State;
(k) Exercising rights of supervision and inspection provided for in the
laws and regulations of the sending State in respect of vessels having
the nationality of the sending State, and of aircraft registered in
that State, and in respect of their crews;
594 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(l) extending assistance to vessels and aircraft mentioned in subparagraph (k) of this Article, and to their crews, taking statements regarding the voyage of a vessel, examining and stamping the ship’s papers, and, without prejudice to the powers of the authorities of the receiving State, conducting investigations into any incidents which occurred during the voyage, and settling disputes of any kind between the master, the officers and the seamen in so far as this may be authorized by the laws and regulations of the sending State;
(m) performing any other functions entrusted to a consular post by the sending State which are not prohibited by the laws and regulations of the receiving State or to which no objection is taken by the receiving State or which are referred to in the international agreements in force between the sending State and the receiving State.
ARTICLE 6

Exercise of consular functions outside the consular district

A consular officer may, in special circumstances, with the consent of the receiving
State, exercise his functions outside his consular district.
ARTICLE 7

Exercise of consular functions in a third State

The sending State may, after notifying the States concerned, entrust a consular
post established in a particular State with the exercise of consular functions in
another State, unless there is express objection by one of the States concerned.
ARTICLE 8

Exercise of consular functions on behalf of a third State

Upon appropriate notification to the receiving State, a consular post of the sending
State may, unless the receiving State objects, exercise consular functions in the
receiving State on behalf of a third State.
ARTICLE 9

Classes of heads of consular posts

1. Heads of consular posts are divided into four classes, namely:
(a) consuls-general;
(b) consuls;
(c) vice-consuls;
(d) consular agents.
2. Paragraph 1 of this Article in no way restricts the right of any of the
Contracting Parties to fix the designation of consular officers other than the heads
of consular posts.
ARTICLE 10

Appointment and admission of heads of consular posts

1. Heads of consular posts are appointed by the sending State and are
admitted to the exercise of their functions by the receiving State.
2. Subject to the provisions of the present Convention, the formalities for
the appointment and for the admission of the head of a consular post are
determined by the laws, regulations and usages of the sending State and of the
receiving State respectively.

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

595
ARTICLE 11

The consular commission or notification of appointment

1. The head of a consular post shall be provided by the sending State
with a document, in the form of a commission or similar instrument, made out for
each appointment, certifying his capacity and showing, as a general rule, his full
name, his category and class, the consular district and the seat of the consular
post.
2. The sending State shall transmit the commission or similar instrument through the diplomatic or other appropriate channel to the Government of the State in whose territory the head of a consular post is to exercise his functions.
3. If the receiving State agrees, the sending State may, instead of a commission or similar instrument, send to the receiving State a notification containing the particulars required by paragraph 1 of this Article.
ARTICLE 12

The exequatur

1. The head of a consular post is admitted to the exercise of his functions
by an authorization from the receiving State termed an exequatur, whatever the
form of this authorization.
2. A State which refuses to grant an exequatur is not obliged to give to the
sending State reasons for such refusal.
3. Subject to the provisions of Articles 13 and 15, the head of a consular
post shall not enter upon his duties until he has received an exequatur.
ARTICLE 13

Provisional admission of heads of consular posts

Pending the delivery of the exequatur, the head of a consular post may be admitted
on a provisional basis to the exercise of his functions. In that case, the provisions
of the present Convention shall apply.
ARTICLE 14

Notification to the authorities of the consular district

As soon as the head of a consular post is admitted even provisionally to the exercise
of his functions, the receiving State shall immediately notify the competent
authorities of the consular district. It shall also ensure that the necessary measures
are taken to enable the head of a consular post to carry out the duties of his office
and to have the benefit of the provisions of the present Convention.
ARTICLE 15

Temporary exercise of the functions of the head of a consular post

1. If the head of a consular post is unable to carry out his functions or the
position of head of consular post is vacant, an acting head of post may act
provisionally as head of the consular post.
2. The full name of the acting head of post shall be notified either by the
diplomatic mission of the sending State or, if that State has no such mission in the
receiving State, by the head of the consular post, or, if he is unable to do so, by any
competent authority of the sending State, to the Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the
receiving State or to the authority designated by that Ministry. As a general rule,
this notification shall be given in advance. The receiving State may make the
admission as acting head of post of a person who is neither a diplomatic agent nor
a consular officer of the sending State in the receiving State conditional on its
consent.
596 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
3. The competent authorities of the receiving State shall afford assistance and protection to the acting head of post. While he is in charge of the post, the provisions of the present Convention shall apply to him on the same basis as to the head of the consular post concerned. The receiving State shall not, however, be obliged to grant to an acting head of post any facility, privilege or immunity which the head of the consular post enjoys only subject to conditions not fulfilled by the acting head of post.
4. When, in the circumstances referred to in paragraph 1 of this Article, a member of the diplomatic staff of the diplomatic mission of the sending State in the receiving State is designated by the sending State as an acting head of post, he shall, if the receiving State does not object thereto, continue to enjoy diplomatic privileges and immunities.
ARTICLE 16

Precedence as between heads of consular posts

1. Heads of consular posts shall rank in each class according to the date
of the grant of the exequatur.
2. If, however, the head of a consular post before obtaining the exequatur
is admitted to the exercise of his functions provisionally, his precedence shall be
determined according to the date of the provisional admission; this precedence
shall be maintained after the granting of the exequatur.
3. The order of precedence as between two or more heads of consular
posts who obtained the exequatur or provisional admission on the same date shall
be determined according to the dates on which their commissions or similar
instruments or the notifications referred to in paragraph 3 of Article 11 were
presented to the receiving State.
4. Acting heads of posts shall rank after all heads of consular posts and,
as between themselves, they shall rank according to the dates on which they
assumed their functions as acting heads of posts as indicated in the notifications
given under paragraph 2 of Article 15.
5. Honorary consular officers who are heads of consular posts shall rank
in each class after career heads of consular posts, in the order and according to the
rules laid down in the foregoing paragraphs.
6. Heads of consular posts shall have precedence over consular officers
not having that status.
ARTICLE 17

Performance of diplomatic acts by consular officers

1. In a State where the sending State has no diplomatic mission and is not
represented by a diplomatic mission of a third State, a consular officer may, with
the consent of the receiving State, and without affecting his consular status, be
authorized to perform diplomatic acts. The performance of such acts by a consular
officer shall not confer upon him any right to claim diplomatic privileges and
immunities.
2. A consular officer may, after notification addressed to the receiving State,
act as representative of the sending State to any inter-governmental organization.
When so acting, he shall be entitled to enjoy any privileges and immunities
accorded to such a representative by customary international law or by
international agreements; however, in respect of the performance by him of any
consular function, he shall not be entitled to any greater immunity from jurisdiction
than that to which a consular officer is entitled under the present Convention.

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

597
ARTICLE 18

Appointment of the same person by two or more States as a consular officer

Two or more States may, with the consent of the receiving State, appoint the same
person as a consular officer in that State.
ARTICLE 19

Appointment of members of consular staff

1. Subject to the provisions of Articles 20, 22 and 23, the sending State
may freely appoint the members of the consular staff.
2. The full name, category and class of all consular officers, other than the
head of a consular post, shall be notified by the sending State to the receiving
State in sufficient time for the receiving State, if it so wishes, to exercise its rights
under paragraph 3 of Article 23.
3. The sending State may, if required by its laws and regulations, request
the receiving State to grant an exequatur to a consular officer other than the head
of a consular post.
4. The receiving State may, if required by its laws and regulations, grant
an exequatur to a consular officer other than the head of a consular post.
ARTICLE 20

Size of the consular staff

In the absence of an express agreement as to the size of the consular staff, the
receiving State may require that the size of the staff be kept within limits considered
by it to be reasonable and normal, having regard to circumstances and conditions
in the consular district and to the needs of the particular post.
ARTICLE 21

Precedence as between consular officers of a consular post

The order of precedence as between the consular officers of a consular post and
any change thereof shall be notified by the diplomatic mission of the sending
State or, if that State has no such mission in the receiving State, by the head of the
consular post, to the Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the receiving State or to the
authority designated by that Ministry.
ARTICLE 22

Nationality of consular officers

1. Consular officers should, in principle, have the nationality of the
sending State.
2. Consular officers may not be appointed from among persons having
the nationality of the receiving State except with the express consent of that State
which may be withdrawn at any time.
3. The receiving State may reserve the same right with regard to nationals
of a third State who are not also nationals of the sending State.
ARTICLE 23

Persons declared non grata

1. The receiving State may at any time notify the sending State that a
consular officer is persona non grata or that any other member of the consular staff
is not acceptable. In that event, the sending State shall, as the case may be, either
recall the person concerned or terminate his functions with the consular post.
598 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
2. If the sending State refuses or fails within a reasonable time to carry out its obligations under paragraph 1 of this Article, the receiving State may, as the case may be, either withdraw the exequatur from the person concerned or cease to consider him as a member of the consular staff.
3. A person appointed as a member of a consular post may be declared unacceptable before arriving in the territory of the receiving State or, if already in the receiving State, before entering on his duties with the consular post. In any such case, the sending State shall withdraw his appointment.
4. In the cases mentioned in paragraphs 1 and 3 of this Article, the receiving
State is not obliged to give to the sending State reasons for its decision.
ARTICLE 24

Notification to the receiving State of appointments, arrivals and departures

1. The Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the receiving State or the authority
designated by that Ministry shall be notified of:
(a) The appointment of members of a consular post, their arrival after
appointment to the consular post, their final departure or the
termination of their functions and any other changes affecting their
status that may occur in the course of their service with the consular
post;
(b) The arrival and final departure of a person belonging to the family
of a member of a consular post forming part of his household and,
where appropriate, the fact that a person becomes or ceases to be
such a member of the family;
(c) The arrival and final departure of members of the private staff and,
where appropriate, the termination of their service as such;
(d) The engagement and discharge of persons resident in the receiving
State as members of a consular post or as members of the private
staff entitled to privileges and immunities.
2. When possible, prior notification of arrival and final departure shall
also be given.
SECTION 2 – END OF CONSULAR FUNCTIONS ARTICLE 25

Termination of the functions of a member of a consular post

The functions of a member of a consular post shall come to an end inter alia:
(a) On notification by the sending State to the receiving State that his
functions have come to an end;
(b) On withdrawal of the exequatur;
(c) On notification by the receiving State to the sending State that the
receiving State has ceased to consider him as a member of the
consular staff.
ARTICLE 26

Departure from the territory of the receiving State

The receiving State shall, even in case of armed conflict, grant to members of the
consular post and members of the private staff, other than nationals of the receiving
State, and to members of their families forming part of their households irrespective
of nationality, the necessary time and facilities to enable them to prepare their
departure and to leave at the earliest possible moment after the termination of the
functions of the members concerned. In particular, it shall, in the case of need,

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

599
place at their disposal the necessary means of transport for themselves and their property other than property acquired in the receiving State the export of which is prohibited at the time of departure.
ARTICLE 27

Protection of consular premises and archives and of the interests of the

sending State in exceptional circumstances

1. In the event of the severance of consular relations between two States:
(a) The receiving State shall, even in case of armed conflict, respect
and protect the consular premises, together with the property of
the consular post and the consular archives;
(b) The sending State may entrust the custody of the consular premises,
together with the property contained therein and the consular
archives, to a third State acceptable to the receiving State;
(c) The sending State may entrust the protection of its interests and
those of its nationals to a third State acceptable to the receiving
State.
2. In the event of the temporary or permanent closure of a consular post,
the provisions of sub-paragraph (a) of paragraph 1 of this Article shall apply. In
addition,
(a) If the sending State, although not represented in the receiving State by a diplomatic mission, has another consular post in the territory of that State, that consular post may be entrusted with the custody of the premises of the consular post which has been closed, together with the property contained therein and the consular archives, and, with the consent of the receiving State, with the exercise of consular functions in the district of that consular post; or
(b) If the sending State has no diplomatic mission and no other consular post in the receiving State, the provisions of sub-paragraphs (b) and (c) of paragraph 1 of this Article shall apply.
CHAPTER 2 – FACILITIES, PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES RELATING TO CONSULAR POSTS, CAREER CONSULAR OFFICERS AND OTHER MEMBERS OF A CONSULAR POST
SECTION 1 – FACILITIES, PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES RELATING TO A CONSULAR POST
ARTICLE 28

Facilities for the work of the consular post

The receiving State shall accord full facilities for the performance of the functions
of the consular post.
ARTICLE 29

Use of national flag and coat-of-arms

1. The sending State shall have the right to the use of its national flag and
coat-of-arms in the receiving State in accordance with the provisions of this Article.
2. The national flag of the sending State may be flown and its coat-of­
arms displayed on the building occupied by the consular post and at the entrance
door thereof, on the residence of the head of the consular post and on his means of
transport when used on official business.
600 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
3. In the exercise of the right accorded by this Article regard shall be had to the laws, regulations and usages of the receiving State.
ARTICLE 30

Accommodation

1. The receiving State shall either facilitate the acquisition on its territory,
in accordance with its laws and regulations, by the sending State of premises
necessary for its consular posts or assist the latter in obtaining accommodation in
some other way.
2. It shall also, where necessary, assist the consular post in obtaining
suitable accommodation for its members.
ARTICLE 31

Inviolability of the consular premises

1. Consular premises shall be inviolable to the extent provided in this
Article.
2. The authorities of the receiving State shall not enter that part of the
consular premises which is used exclusively for the purpose of the work of the
consular post except with the consent of the head of the consular post or of his
designee or of the head of the diplomatic mission of the sending State. The consent
of the head of the consular post may, however, be assumed in case of fire or other
disaster requiring prompt protective action.
3. Subject to the provisions of paragraph 2 of this Article, the receiving
State is under a special duty to take all appropriate steps to protect the consular
premises against any intrusion or damage and to prevent any disturbance of the
peace of the consular post or impairment of its dignity.
4. The consular premises, their furnishings, the property of the consular
post and its means of transport shall be immune from any form of requisition for
purposes of national defence or public utility. If expropriation is necessary for
such purposes, all possible steps shall be taken to avoid impeding the performance
of consular functions, and prompt, adequate and effective compensation shall be
paid to the sending State.
ARTICLE 32

Exemption from taxation of consular premises

1. Consular premises and the residence of the career head of consular
post of which the sending State or any person acting on its behalf is the owner or
lessee shall be exempt from all national, regional or municipal dues and taxes
whatsoever, other than such as represent payment for specific services rendered.
2. The exemption from taxation referred to in paragraph 1 of this Article
shall not apply to such dues and taxes if, under the law of the receiving State, they
are payable by the person who contracted with the sending State or with the person
acting on its behalf.
ARTICLE 33

Inviolability of the consular archives and documents

The consular archives and documents shall be inviolable at all times and wherever
they may be.
ARTICLE 34

Freedom of movement

Subject to its laws and regulations concerning zones entry into which is prohibited
or regulated for reasons of national security, the receiving State shall ensure freedom
of movement and travel in its territory to all members of the consular post.

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

601
ARTICLE 35

Freedom of communication

1. The receiving State shall permit and protect freedom of communication
on the part of the consular post for all official purposes. In communicating with
the Government, the diplomatic missions and other consular posts, wherever
situated, of the sending State, the consular post may employ all appropriate means,
including diplomatic or consular couriers, diplomatic or consular bags and
messages in code or cipher. However, the consular post may install and use a
wireless transmitter only with the consent of the receiving State.
2. The official correspondence of the consular post shall be inviolable.
Official correspondence means all correspondence relating to the consular post
and its functions.
3. The consular bag shall be neither opened nor detained. Nevertheless,
if the competent authorities of the receiving State have serious reason to believe
that the bag contains something other than the correspondence, documents or
articles referred to in paragraph 4 of this Article, they may request that the bag be
opened in their presence by an authorized representative of the sending State. If
his request is refused by the authorities of the sending State, the bag shall be
returned to its place of origin.
4. The packages constituting the consular bag shall bear visible external
marks of their character and may contain only official correspondence and
documents or articles intended exclusively for official use.
5. The consular courier shall be provided with an official document
indicating his status and the number of packages constituting the consular bag.
Except with the consent of the receiving State he shall be neither a national of the
receiving State, nor, unless he is a national of the sending State, a permanent
resident of the receiving State. In the performance of his functions he shall be
protected by the receiving State. He shall enjoy personal inviolability and shall
not be liable to any form of arrest or detention.
6. The sending State, its diplomatic missions and its consular posts may
designate consular couriers ad hoc. In such cases the provisions of paragraph 5 of
this Article shall also apply except that the immunities therein mentioned shall
cease to apply when such a courier has delivered to the consignee the consular
bag in his charge.
7. A consular bag may be entrusted to the captain of a ship or of a
commercial aircraft scheduled to land at an authorised port of entry. He shall be
provided with an official document indicating the number of packages constituting
the bag, but he shall not be considered to be a consular courier. By arrangement
with the appropriate local authorities, the consular post may send one of its
members to take possession of the bag directly and freely from the captain of the
ship or of the aircraft.
ARTICLE 36

Communication and contact with nationals of the sending State

1. With a view to facilitating the exercise of consular functions relating to
nationals of the sending State:
(a) consular officers shall be free to communicate with nationals of the
sending State and to have access to them. Nationals of the sending
State shall have the same freedom with respect to communication
with and access to consular officers of the sending State;
602 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) if he so requests, the competent authorities of the receiving State shall, without delay, inform the consular post of the sending State if, within its consular district, a national of that State is arrested or committed to prison or to custody pending trial or is detained in any other manner. Any communication addressed to the consular post by the person arrested, in prison, custody or detention shall also be forwarded by the said authorities without delay. The said authorities shall inform the person concerned without delay of his rights under this sub-paragraph;
(c) consular officers shall have the right to visit a national of the sending State who is in prison, custody or detention, to converse and correspond with him and to arrange for his legal representation. They shall also have the right to visit any national of the sending State who is in prison, custody or detention in their district in pursuance of a judgment. Nevertheless, consular officers shall refrain from taking action on behalf of a national who is in prison, custody or detention if he expressly opposes such action.
2. The rights referred to in paragraph 1 of this Article shall be exercised in
conformity with the laws and regulations of the receiving State, subject to the
proviso, however, that the said laws and regulations must enable full effect to be
given to the purposes for which the rights accorded under this Article are intended.
ARTICLE 37

Information in cases of deaths, guardianship or trusteeship, wrecks and air

accidents

If the relevant information is available to the competent authorities of the receiving
State, such authorities shall have the duty:
(a) In the case of the death of a national of the sending State, to inform
without delay the consular post in whose district the death occurred;
(b) To inform the competent consular post without delay of any case
where the appointment of a guardian or trustee appears to be in
the interests of a minor or other person lacking full capacity who is
a national of the sending State. The giving of this information shall,
however, be without prejudice to the operation of the laws and
regulations of the receiving State concerning such appointments;
(c) If a vessel, having the nationality of the sending State, is wrecked
or runs aground in the territorial sea or internal waters of the
receiving State, or if an aircraft registered in the sending State suffers
an accident on the territory of the receiving State, to inform without
delay the consular post nearest to the scene of the occurrence.
ARTICLE 38

Communication with the authorities of the receiving State

In the exercise of their functions, consular officers may address:
(a) The competent local authorities of their consular district;
(b) The competent central authorities of the receiving State if and to
the extent that this is allowed by the laws, regulations and usages
of the receiving State or by the relevant international agreements.

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

603
ARTICLE 39

Consular fees and charges

1. The consular post may levy in the territory of the receiving State the
fees and charges provided by the laws and regulations of the sending State for
consular acts.
2. The sums collected in the form of the fees and charges referred to in
paragraph 1 of this Article, and the receipts for such fees and charges, shall be
exempt from all dues and taxes in the receiving State.
SECTION 2 – FACILITIES, PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES RELATING TO CAREER CONSULAR OFFICERS AND OTHER MEMBERS OF A CONSULAR POST
ARTICLE 40

Protection of consular officers

The receiving State shall treat consular officers with due respect and shall take all
appropriate steps to prevent any attack on their person, freedom or dignity.
ARTICLE 41

Personal inviolability of consular officers

1. Consular officers shall not be liable to arrest or detention pending trial,
except in the case of a grave crime and pursuant to a decision by the competent
judicial authority.
2. Except in the case specified in paragraph 1 of this Article, consular
officers shall not be committed to prison or liable to any other form of restriction
on their personal freedom save in execution of a judicial decision of final effect.
3. If criminal proceedings are instituted against a consular officer, he must
appear before the competent authorities. Nevertheless, the proceedings shall be
conducted with the respect due to him by reason of his official position and, except
in the case specified in paragraph 1 of this Article, in a manner which will hamper
the exercise of consular functions as little as possible. When, in the circumstances
mentioned in paragraph 1 of this Article, it has become necessary to detain a
consular officer, the proceedings against him shall be instituted with the minimum
of delay.
ARTICLE 42

Notification of arrest, detention or prosecution

In the event of the arrest or detention, pending trial, of a member of the consular
staff, or of criminal proceedings being instituted against him, the receiving State
shall promptly notify the head of the consular post. Should the latter be himself
the object of any such measure, the receiving State shall notify the sending State
through the diplomatic channel.
ARTICLE 43

Immunity from jurisdiction

1. Consular officers and consular employees shall not be amenable to the
jurisdiction of the judicial or administrative authorities of the receiving State in
respect of acts performed in the exercise of consular functions.
2. The provisions of paragraph 1 of this Article shall not, however, apply
in respect of a civil action either:
604 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(a) arising out of a contract concluded by a consular officer or a consular employee in which he did not contract expressly or impliedly as an agent of the sending State; or
(b) by a third party for damage arising from an accident in the receiving
State caused by a vehicle, vessel or aircraft.
ARTICLE 44

Liability to give evidence

1. Members of a consular post may be called upon to attend as witnesses
in the course of judicial or administrative proceedings. A consular employee or a
member of the service staff shall not, except in the cases mentioned in paragraph
3 of this Article, decline to give evidence. If a consular officer should decline to do
so, no coercive measure or penalty may be applied to him.
2. The authority requiring the evidence of a consular officer shall avoid
interference with the performance of his functions. It may, when possible, take
such evidence at his residence or at the consular post or accept a statement from
him in writing.
3. Members of a consular post are under no obligation to give evidence
concerning matters connected with the exercise of their functions or to produce
official correspondence and documents relating thereto. They are also entitled to
decline to give evidence as expert witnesses with regard to the law of the sending
State.
ARTICLE 45

Waiver of privileges and immunities

1. The sending State may waive, with regard to a member of the consular
post, any of the privileges and immunities provided for in Articles 41, 43 and 44.
2. The waiver shall in all cases be express, except as provided in paragraph
3 of this Article, and shall be communicated to the receiving State in writing.
3. The initiation of proceedings by a consular officer or a consular
employee in a matter where he might enjoy immunity from jurisdiction under
Article 43 shall preclude him from invoking immunity from jurisdiction in respect
of any counter-claim directly connected with the principal claim.
4. The waiver of immunity from jurisdiction for the purposes of civil or
administrative proceedings shall not be deemed to imply the waiver of immunity
from the measures of execution resulting from the judicial decision; in respect of
such measures, a separate waiver shall be necessary.
ARTICLE 46

Exemption from registration of aliens and residence permits

1. Consular officers and consular employees and members of their families
forming part of their households shall be exempt from all obligations under the
laws and regulations of the receiving State in regard to the registration of aliens
and residence permits.
2. The provisions of paragraph 1 of this Article shall not, however, apply
to any consular employee who is not a permanent employee of the sending State
or who carries on any private gainful occupation in the receiving State or to any
member of the family of any such employee.

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

605
ARTICLE 47

Exemption from work permits

1. Members of the consular post shall, with respect to services rendered
for the sending State, be exempt from any obligations in regard to work permits
imposed by the laws and regulations of the receiving State concerning the
employment of foreign labour.
2. Members of the private staff of consular officers and of consular
employees shall, if they do not carry on any other gainful occupation in the
receiving State, be exempt from the obligations referred to in paragraph 1 of this
Article.
ARTICLE 48

Social security exemption

1. Subject to the provisions of paragraph 3 of this Article, members of the
consular post with respect to services rendered by them for the sending State, and
members of their families forming part of their households, shall be exempt from
social security provisions which may be in force in the receiving State.
2. The exemption provided for in paragraph 1 of this Article shall apply
also to members of the private staff who are in the sole employ of members of the
consular post, on condition:
(a) that they are not nationals of or permanently resident in the
receiving State; and
(b) that they are covered by the social security provisions which are in
force in the sending State or a third State.
3. Members of the consular post who employ persons to whom the
exemption provided for in paragraph 2 of this Article does not apply shall observe
the obligations which the social security provisions of the receiving State impose
upon employers.
4. The exemption provided for in paragraphs 1 and 2 of this Article shall
not preclude voluntary participation in the social security system of the receiving
State, provided that such participation is permitted by that State.
ARTICLE 49

Exemption from taxation

1. Consular officers and consular employees and members of their families
forming part of their households shall be exempt from all dues and taxes, personal
or real, national, regional or municipal, except:
(a) indirect taxes of a kind which are normally incorporated in the price
of goods or services;
(b) dues or taxes on private immovable property situated in the territory
of the receiving State, subject to the provisions of Article 32;
(c) estate, succession or inheritance duties, and duties on transfers,
levied by the receiving State, subject to the provisions of paragraph
(b) of Article 51;
(d) dues and taxes on private income, including capital gains, having
its source in the receiving State and capital taxes relating to
investments made in commercial or financial undertakings in the
receiving State;
(e) charges levied for specific services rendered;
(f) registration, court or record fees, mortgage dues and stamp duties,
subject to the provisions of Article 32.
2. Members of the service staff shall be exempt from dues and taxes on
the wages which they receive for their services.
606 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
3. Members of the consular post who employ persons whose wages or salaries are not exempt from income tax in the receiving State shall observe the obligations which the laws and regulations of that State impose upon employers concerning the levying of income tax.
ARTICLE 50

Exemption from customs duties and inspection

1. The receiving State shall, in accordance with such laws and regulations
as it may adopt, permit entry of and grant exemption from all customs duties,
taxes, and related charges other than charges for storage, cartage and similar
services, on:
(a) articles for the official use of the consular post;
(b) articles for the personal use of a consular officer or members of his
family forming part of his household, including articles intended
for his establishment. The articles intended for consumption shall
not exceed the quantities necessary for direct utilisation by the
persons concerned.
2. Consular employees shall enjoy the privileges and exemptions specified
in paragraph 1 of this Article in respect of articles imported at the time of first
installation.
3. Personal baggage accompanying consular officers and members of their
families forming part of their households shall be exempt from inspection. It may
be inspected only if there is serious reason to believe that it contains articles other
than those referred to in sub-paragraph (b) of paragraph 1 of this Article, or articles
the import or export of which is prohibited by the laws and regulations of the
receiving State or which are subject to its quarantine laws and regulations. Such
inspection shall be carried out in the presence of the consular officer or member of
his family concerned.
ARTICLE 51

Estate of a member of the consular post or of a member of his family

In the event of the death of a member of the consular post or of a member of his
family forming part of his household, the receiving State:
(a) shall permit the export of the movable property of the deceased,
with the exception of any such property acquired in the receiving
State the export of which was prohibited at the time of his death;
(b) shall not levy national, regional or municipal estate, succession or
inheritance duties, and duties on transfers, on movable property
the presence of which in the receiving State was due solely to the
presence in that State of the deceased as a member of the consular
post or as a member of the family of a member of the consular post.
ARTICLE 52

Exemption from personal services and contributions

The receiving State shall exempt members of the consular post and members of
their families forming part of their households from all personal services, from all
public service of any kind whatsoever, and from military obligations such as those
connected with requisitioning, military contributions and billeting.
ARTICLE 53

Beginning and end of consular privileges and immunities

1. Every member of the consular post shall enjoy the privileges and

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

607
immunities provided in the present Convention from the moment he enters the territory of the receiving State on proceeding to take up his post or, if already in its territory, from the moment when he enters on his duties with the consular post.
2. Members of the family of a member of the consular post forming part of his household and members of his private staff shall receive the privileges and immunities provided in the present Convention from the date from which he enjoys privileges and immunities in accordance with paragraph 1 of this Article or from the date of their entry into the territory of the receiving State or from the date of their becoming a member of such family or private staff, whichever is the latest.
3. When the functions of a member of the consular post have come to an end, his privileges and immunities and those of a member of his family forming part of his household or a member of his private staff shall normally cease at the moment when the person concerned leaves the receiving State or on the expiry of a reasonable period in which to do so, whichever is the sooner, but shall subsist until that time, even in case of armed conflict. In the case of the persons referred to in paragraph 2 of this Article, their privileges and immunities shall come to an end when they cease to belong to the household or to be in the service of a member of the consular post provided, however, that if such persons intend leaving the receiving State within a reasonable period thereafter, their privileges and immunities shall subsist until the time of their departure.
4. However, with respect to acts performed by a consular officer or a
consular employee in the exercise of his functions, immunity from jurisdiction
shall continue to subsist without limitation of time.
5. In the event of the death of a member of the consular post, the members
of his family forming part of his household shall continue to enjoy the privileges
and immunities accorded to them until they leave the receiving State or until the
expiry of a reasonable period enabling them to do so, whichever is the sooner.
ARTICLE 54

Obligations of third States

1. If a consular officer passes through or is in the territory of a third State,
which has granted him a visa if a visa was necessary, while proceeding to take up
or return to his post or when returning to the sending State, the third State shall
accord to him all immunities provided for by the other Articles of the present
Convention as may be required to ensure his transit or return. The same shall
apply in the case of any member of his family forming part of his household
enjoying such privileges and immunities who are accompanying the consular
officer or travelling separately to join him or to return to the sending State.
2. In circumstances similar to those specified in paragraph 1 of this Article,
third States shall not hinder the transit through their territory of other members
of the consular post or of members of their families forming part of their
households.
3. Third States shall accord to official correspondence and to other official
communications in transit, including messages in code or cipher, the same freedom
and protection as the receiving State is bound to accord under the present
Convention. They shall accord to consular couriers who have been granted a visa,
if a visa was necessary, and to consular bags in transit, the same inviolability and
protection as the receiving State is bound to accord under the present Convention.
4. The obligations of third States under paragraphs 1, 2 and 3 of this Article
shall also apply to the persons mentioned respectively in those paragraphs, and
to official communications and to consular bags, whose presence in the territory
of the third State is due to force majeure.
608 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
ARTICLE 55

Respect for the laws and regulations of the receiving State

1. Without prejudice to their privileges and immunities, it is the duty of
all persons enjoying such privileges and immunities to respect the laws and
regulations of the receiving State. They also have a duty not to interfere in the
internal affairs of that State.
2. The consular premises shall not be used in any manner incompatible
with the exercise of consular functions.
3. The provisions of paragraph 2 of this Article shall not exclude the
possibility of offices of other institutions or agencies being installed in part of the
building in which the consular premises are situated, provided that the premises
assigned to them are separate from those used by the consular post. In that event,
the said offices shall not, for the purposes of the present Convention, be considered
to form part of the consular premises.
ARTICLE 56

Insurance against third party risks

Members of the consular post shall comply with any requirement imposed by the
laws and regulations of the receiving State in respect of insurance against third
party risks arising from the use of any vehicle, vessel or aircraft.
ARTICLE 57

Special provisions concerning private gainful occupation

1. Career consular officers shall not carry on for personal profit any
professional or commercial activity in the receiving State.
2. Privileges and immunities provided in this Chapter shall not be
accorded:
(a) to consular employees or to members of the service staff who carry on any private gainful occupation in the receiving State;
(b) to members of the family of a person referred to in sub-paragraph
(a) of this paragraph or to members of his private staff;
(c) to members of the family of a member of a consular post who
themselves carry on any private gainful occupation in the receiving
State.
CHAPTER 3—REGIME RELATING TO HONORARY CONSULAR OFFICERS AND CONSULAR POSTS HEADED BY SUCH OFFICERS
ARTICLE 58

General provisions relating to facilities, privileges and immunities

1. Articles 28, 29, 30, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38 and 39, paragraph 3 of Article 54
and paragraphs 2 and 3 of Article 55 shall apply to consular posts headed by an
honorary consular officer. In addition, the facilities, privileges and immunities of
such consular posts shall be governed by Articles 59, 60, 61 and 62.
2. Articles 42 and 43, paragraph 3 of Article 44, Articles 45 and 53 and
paragraph 1 of Article 55 shall apply to honorary consular officers. In addition,
the facilities, privileges and immunities of such consular officers shall be governed
by Articles 63, 64, 65, 66 and 67.
3. Privileges and immunities provided in the present Convention shall
not be accorded to members of the family of an honorary consular officer or of a
consular employee employed at a consular post headed by an honorary consular
officer.

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

609
4. The exchange of consular bags between two consular posts headed by honorary consular officers in different States shall not be allowed without the consent of the two receiving States concerned.
ARTICLE 59

Protection of the consular premises

The receiving State shall take such steps as may be necessary to protect the consular
premises of a consular post headed by an honorary consular officer against any
intrusion or damage and to prevent any disturbance of the peace of the consular
post or impairment of its dignity.
ARTICLE 60

Exemption from taxation of consular premises

1. Consular premises of a consular post headed by an honorary consular
officer of which the sending State is the owner or lessee shall be exempt from all
national, regional or municipal dues and taxes whatsoever, other than such as
represent payment for specific services rendered.
2. The exemption from taxation referred to in paragraph 1 of this Article
shall not apply to such dues and taxes if, under the laws and regulations of the
receiving State, they are payable by the person who contracted with the sending
State.
ARTICLE 61

Inviolability of consular archives and documents

The consular archives and documents of a consular post headed by an honorary
consular officer shall be inviolable at all times and wherever they may be, provided
that they are kept separate from other papers and documents and, in particular,
from the private correspondence of the head of a consular post and of any person
working with him, and from the materials, books or documents relating to their
profession or trade.
ARTICLE 62

Exemption from customs duties

The receiving State shall, in accordance with such laws and regulations as it may
adopt, permit entry of, and grant exemption from all customs duties, taxes, and
related charges other than charges for storage, cartage and similar services on the
following articles, provided that they are for the official use of a consular post
headed by an honorary consular officer: coats-of-arms, flags, signboards, seals
and stamps, books, official printed matter, office furniture, office equipment and
similar articles supplied by or at the instance of the sending State to the consular
post.
ARTICLE 63

Criminal Proceedings

If criminal proceedings are instituted against an honorary consular officer, he must
appear before the competent authorities. Nevertheless, the proceedings, shall be
conducted with the respect due to him by reason of his official position and, except
when he is under arrest or detention, in a manner which will hamper the exercise
of consular functions as little as possible. When it has become necessary to detain
an honorary consular officer, the proceedings against him shall be instituted with
the minimum of delay.
610 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
ARTICLE 64

Protection of honorary consular officers

The receiving State is under a duty to accord to an honorary consular officer such
protection as may be required by reason of his official position.
ARTICLE 65

Exemption from registration of aliens and residence permits

Honorary consular officers, with the exception of those who carry on for personal
profit any professional or commercial activity in the receiving State, shall be exempt
from all obligations under the laws and regulations of the receiving State in regard
to the registration of aliens and residence permits.
ARTICLE 66

Exemption from taxation

An honorary consular officer shall be exempt from all dues and taxes on the
remuneration and emoluments which he receives from the sending State in respect
of the exercise of consular functions.
ARTICLE 67

Exemption from personal services and contributions

The receiving State shall exempt honorary consular officers from all personal
services and from all public services of any kind whatsoever and from military
obligations such as those connected with requisitioning, military contributions
and billeting.
ARTICLE 68

Optional character of the institution of honorary consular officers

Each State is free to decide whether it will appoint or receive honorary consular
officers.
CHAPTER 4 – GENERAL PROVISIONS ARTICLE 69

Consular agents who are not heads of consular posts

1. Each State is free to decide whether it will establish or admit consular
agencies conducted by consular agents not designated as heads of consular post
by the sending State.
2. The conditions under which the consular agencies referred to in
paragraph 1 of this Article may carry on their activities and the privileges and
immunities which may be enjoyed by the consular agents in charge of them shall
be determined by agreement between the sending State and the receiving State.
ARTICLE 70

Exercise of consular functions by diplomatic missions

1. The provisions of the present Convention apply also, so far as the context
permits, to the exercise of consular functions by a diplomatic mission.
2. The names of members of a diplomatic mission assigned to the consular
section or otherwise charged with the exercise of the consular functions of the
mission shall be notified to the Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the receiving State
or to the authority designated by that Ministry.
3. In the exercise of consular functions a diplomatic mission may address:
(a) the local authorities of the consular district;

Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971

611
(b) the central authorities of the receiving State if this is allowed by the laws, regulations and usages of the receiving State or by relevant international agreements.
4. The privileges and immunities of the members of a diplomatic mission referred to in paragraph 2 of this Article shall continue to be governed by the rules of international law concerning diplomatic relations.
ARTICLE 71

Nationals or permanent residents of the receiving State

1. Except in so far as additional facilities, privileges and immunities may
be granted by the receiving State, consular officers who are nationals of or
permanently resident in the receiving State shall enjoy only immunity from
jurisdiction and personal inviolability in respect of official acts performed in the
exercise of their functions, and the privilege provided in paragraph 3 of Article
44. So far as these consular officers are concerned, the receiving State shall likewise
be bound by the obligation laid down in Article 42. If criminal proceedings are
instituted against such a consular officer, the proceedings shall, except when he is
under arrest or detention, be conducted in a manner which will hamper the exercise
of consular functions as little as possible.
2. Other members of the consular post who are nationals of or permanently
resident in the receiving State and members of their families, as well as members
of the families of consular officers referred to in paragraph 1 of this Article, shall
enjoy facilities, privileges and immunities only in so far as these are granted to
them by the receiving State. Those members of the families of members of the
consular post and those members of the private staff who are themselves nationals
of or permanently resident in the receiving State shall likewise enjoy facilities,
privileges and immunities only in so far as these are granted to them by the
receiving State. The receiving State shall, however, exercise its jurisdiction over
those persons in such a way as not to hinder unduly the performance of the
functions of the consular post.
ARTICLE 72

Non-discrimination

1. In the application of the provisions of the present Convention the
receiving State shall not discriminate as between States.
2. However, discrimination shall not be regarded as taking place:
(a) where the receiving State applies any of the provisions of the present
Convention restrictively because of a restrictive application of that
provision to its consular posts in the sending State;
(b) where by custom or agreement States extend to each other more
favourable treatment than is required by the provisions of the
present Convention.
ARTICLE 73

Relationship between the present Convention and other international

agreements

1. The provisions of the present Convention shall not affect other
international agreements in force as between States parties to them.
2. Nothing in the present Convention shall preclude States from
concluding international agreements confirming or supplementing or extending
or amplifying the provisions thereof.
612 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
CHAPTER 5 – FINAL PROVISIONS ARTICLE 74

Signature

The present Convention shall be open for signature by all States Members of the
United Nations or of any of the specialized agencies or Parties to the Statute of the
International Court of Justice, and by any other State invited by the General
Assembly of the United Nations to become a Party to the Convention, as follows:
until 31 October 1963 at the Federal Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the Republic of
Austria and subsequently, until 31 March 1964, at the United Nations Headquarters
in New York.
ARTICLE 75

Ratification

The present Convention is subject to ratification. The instruments of ratification
shall be deposited with the Secretary-General of the United Nations.
ARTICLE 76

Accession

The present Convention shall remain open for accession by any State belonging to
any of the four categories mentioned in Article 74. The instruments of accession
shall be deposited with the Secretary-General of the United Nations.
ARTICLE 77

Entry into force

1. The present Convention shall enter into force on the thirtieth day
following the date of deposit of the twenty-second instrument of ratification or
accession with the Secretary-General of the United Nations.
2. For each State ratifying or acceding to the Convention after the deposit
of the twenty-second instrument of ratification or accession, the Convention shall
enter into force on the thirtieth day after deposit by such State of its instrument of
ratification or accession.
ARTICLE 78

Notifications by the Secretary-General

The Secretary-General of the United Nations shall inform all States belonging to
any of the four categories mentioned in Article 74:
(a) Of signatures to the present Convention and of the deposit of
instruments of ratification or accession, in accordance with Articles
74, 75 and 76;
(b) Of the date on which the present Convention will enter in force in
accordance with Article 77.
ARTICLE 79

Authentic texts

The original of the present Convention, of which the Chinese, English, French,
Russian and Spanish texts are equally authentic, shall be deposited with the
Secretary-General of the United Nations, who shall send certified copies thereof
to all States belonging to any of the four categories mentioned in Article 74.
613

CONTINENTAL SHELF ACT 1964

1964/28 (NZ) – 3 November 1964

1

Short title

5

Mining for minerals on continental shelf

2

Interpretation

6

[Repealed]

3

Exploration and exploitation of continental

7

Application of criminal and civil law

shelf

8

Regulations

4

Mining for petroleum on continental shelf

9

[Spent]

To make provision as to the exploration and exploitation of the continental shelf of Niue and for matters connected with that purpose

1 Short title

This is the Continental Shelf Act 1964.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“continental shelf” means the seabed and subsoil of those submarine areas
adjacent to the coast of Niue, but beyond the territorial limits of Niue,
the surface of which lies at a depth no greater than 200 metres below
the surface of the sea, or, where the natural resources thereof are capable
of exploitation, at any greater depth;
“natural resources” means –
(a) The mineral and other natural non-living resources of the seabed
and subsoil; and
(b) Living organisms belonging to sedentary species, that is to say,
organisms which, at the harvestable stage, either are immobile on
or under the seabed or are unable to move except in constant
physical contact with the seabed or subsoil.

3 Exploration and exploitation of continental shelf

All rights that are exercisable by Niue with respect to the continental shelf
and its natural resources for the purpose of exploring the shelf and exploiting
those resources are hereby vested in the Crown.

4 Mining for petroleum on continental shelf

The Mining Act 1977 shall, as far as applicable and with any necessary
modification, apply with respect to petroleum in the seabed and subsoil of the
continental shelf.
614 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

5 Mining for minerals on continental shelf

(1) No person shall prospect or mine for, or carry on any operations for the
recovery of, minerals in the seabed or subsoil of the continental shelf except in
pursuance of a licence issued under this section.
(2) Cabinet may on application in that behalf, grant to any person a licence
authorising the licensee to prospect and mine for, and carry on operations for the
recovery of, minerals or of minerals of any specified kinds in any specified area of
the continental shelf.
(3) Every licence granted under this section shall be subject to such
conditions as the Cabinet, when granting the licence, thinks fit to impose in the
circumstances of each particular case, including, but without limiting the generality
of this section, conditions requiring the licensee –
(a) To comply with such conditions as to safety as are specified in the
licence;
(b) To pay to the Crown in respect of minerals recovered by the licensee
from the continental shelf such royalties as are specified in the
licence.
(4) The grant of a licence under this section shall in every case be in the
absolute discretion of Cabinet.
(5) Any number of licences under this section may be granted to the same
person.
(6) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(7) Every person commits an offence, and is liable on conviction to a fine
not exceeding 2 penalty units, who prospects or mines for, or carries on operations
for the recovery of, minerals in the seabed or subsoil of the continental shelf
otherwise than pursuant to a licence under this section and in accordance with
the conditions of the licence (not being a condition relating to the payment of
royalties to the Crown).

6 [Repealed by 2004/270]

7 Application of criminal and civil law

(1) Subject to the provisions of this Act, for the purposes of this Act and of
every other enactment (whether passed before or after the passing of this Act) and
of every rule of law for the time being in force in Niue –
(a) Every act or omission which takes place on or under or above or
about any installation or device (whether permanent or temporary)
constructed, erected, placed, or used in, on, or above the continental
shelf in connection with the exploration of the continental shelf or
the exploitation of its natural resources shall be deemed to take
place in Niue; and
(b) Every such installation or device shall be deemed to be situated in
Niue, and for the purposes of jurisdiction shall be deemed to be
situated in that part of Niue above highwater mark at ordinary
spring tides which is nearest to that installation or device; and
(c) Every court in Niue which would have jurisdiction (whether civil
or criminal) in respect of that act or omission if it had taken place in
Niue shall have jurisdiction accordingly; and
(d) Every power of arrest or of entry or search or seizure or other power
that could be exercised under any enactment (whether passed before
or after the passing of this Act) or under any rule of law in respect
of any such act or omission or suspected act or omission if it had

Continental Shelf Act 1964

615
taken place or was suspected to have taken place in Niue may be exercised on or in respect of any such installation or device as if the installation or device were in Niue; and
(e) Subject to the custom laws, every installation or device, and any materials or parts used in the construction of an installation or device, which are brought into the waters above the continental shelf from parts beyond the seas shall be deemed to have been imported into Niue when the installation or device is constructed, erected, or placed in, on, or above the continental shelf in connection with the exploration of the continental shelf or the exploitation of its natural resources.
(2) [Spent]
(3) Nothing in this section shall limit the provisions of any enactment or
rule of law relating to the liability of persons in respect of acts done or omitted
beyond Niue or the jurisdiction of any Niue court under any such enactment or
rule of law.
(4) Notwithstanding anything in any other enactment, proceedings for the
trial and punishment of any person charged with having committed an offence in
respect of which the courts of Niue have jurisdiction by virtue only of this section
shall not be instituted in any court except with the certificate of Cabinet that it is
expedient that the proceedings should be instituted:
(5) A person so charged may be arrested or a warrant for his arrest may be
issued and executed, and he may be remanded in custody or on bail,
notwithstanding that the consent of the Cabinet to the institution of proceedings
for the offence has not been obtained; but no further or other proceedings shall be
taken until that consent has been obtained.
(6) In this section “device” includes any ship or floating platform or aircraft
that is used in connection with any installation or device.

8 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make regulations for all or any of the following purposes –
(a) Regulating the construction, erection, or use of installations or
devices in, on, or above the continental shelf, or any specified part
thereof, in connection with the exploration of the shelf or that part
thereof or the exploitation of its natural resources;
(b) Prohibiting the construction, erection, placing, or use of installations
or devices in, on, or above the continental shelf in places where
they could cause interference with the use of recognised sea lanes
essential to coastwise or international navigation;
(c) Establishing safety zones, extending to a distance not exceeding
500 metres measured from each point of the outer edge of the
installation or device, around any such installations or devices in,
on, or above the continental shelf;
(d) Prescribing such measures as the Cabinet considers necessary in
any such safety zone for the protection of the installation or device
with respect to which the safety zone is established;
(e) Regulating or prohibiting the entry of ships into any such safety
zone;
(f) Prescribing measures to be taken in any such safety zone for the
protection of the living resources of the sea and the natural resources
of the continental shelf from harmful agents;
616 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(g) Prescribing the notice to be given of the construction, erection, or placing of installations or devices in, on, or above the continental shelf;
(h) Prescribing the permanent means to be installed for the purpose of giving warning to shipping and aircraft of the presence of installations or devices in, on, or above the continental shelf;
(i) Providing for the removal of installations or devices constructed, erected, or placed in, on, or above the continental shelf which have been abandoned or become disused;
(j) Prohibiting or restricting any exploration of the continental shelf or any specified part thereof or any exploitation of its natural resources which in the opinion of the Cabinet could result in an unjustifiable interference with navigation, fishing, or the conservation of the living resources of the sea, or could interfere with national defence or with oceanographic or other scientific research or with submarine cables or pipelines;
(k) Providing for such matters as are necessary for giving full effect to this Act and for its due administration;
(l) Prescribing penalties for breaches of the regulations, not exceeding a fine of 10 penalty units.
(2) In this section “continental shelf” includes the seabed and subsoil of
the submarine areas within the territorial limits of Niue.

9 [Spent]

617

CRIMES AGAINST INTERNATIONALLY PROTECTED PERSONS AND HOSTAGES ACT 1984

1984/86 – 27 September 1984

9 [Spent]

General Provisions

10 Crimes deemed to be included in extradition treaties

11 Surrender of offenders

12 Restrictions on surrender of offenders

13 Further restrictions on surrender of offenders

14 Consent of Cabinet required to prosecutions

15 Evidence

16 [Spent]

17 Other Acts not affected

SCHEDULES

To give effect to the Convention on the Prevention and Punishment of Crimes Against Internationally Protected Persons, including Diplomatic Agents, 1973, and the Convention Against the Taking of Hostages 1979, and for matters incidental to the implementation of those Conventions

1 Short title

This is the Crimes against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages
Act 1984.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“Fugitive Offenders Act 1881” means the Fugitive Offenders Act 1881 of
the Parliament of the United Kingdom (as amended by the Fugitive
Offenders Amendment Act 1976);
“internationally protected person” in relation to an alleged act or omission
that constitutes a crime by virtue of or against any of sections 3 to 6
means –
(a) A person who, at the time of the alleged act or omission, is –
(i) a Head of State; or
(ii) a member of a body that performs the functions of a Head of
State under the constitution of the State; or
(iii) a head of Government; or
(iv) a Minister of Foreign Affairs –
618 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
and is outside the territory of the State in which he holds office;
(b) A member of the family of any person referred to in paragraph (a)
who is accompanying that person;
(c) A person who, at the time of the alleged act or omission, is –
(i) a representative or an official of a State; or
(ii) an official or agent of an international organisation of an
intergovernmental character –
and is entitled under international law to special protection from
attack on his person, freedom, or dignity;
(d) A member of the family of any person referred to in paragraph (c)
who is a member of that person’s household;
“Secretary for Justice” means that member of the Niue Public Service for
the time being holding the office of the head of the Justice Department;
“1973 Convention” means the Convention on the Prevention and
Punishment of Crimes Against Internationally Protected Persons,
including Diplomatic Agents, opened for signature at New York on 14
December 1973;
“1979 Convention” means the Convention Against the Taking of Hostages,
opened for signature at New York on 18 December 1979;
“vehicle” includes any means of conveyance.
(2) In paragraph (a)(i) of the term “internationally protected person” in
subsection (1), the term “Head of State” includes, in relation to any Commonwealth
country (other than the United Kingdom) of which Her Majesty the Queen is Head
of State, the Governor-General or other person who performs the functions of the
Head of State as Her Majesty’s representative.

Internationally Protected Persons

3 Crimes against persons

(1) Without limiting the Niue Act 1966 every one commits a crime who,
whether in or outside Niue, does or omits to do any act to, or in relation to any
person whom he knows to be an internationally protected person, if that act or
omission constitutes, or would, if done or omitted to be done in Niue, constitute –
(a) A crime referred to or described in any of the provisions of the Niue
Act 1966 specified in Schedule 1; or
(b) An attempt to commit any such crime (where the crime is not itself
constituted by a mere attempt).
(2) Every one who commits a crime against this section is liable on
conviction to the same penalty to which he would have been liable had he been
charged with a crime against the relevant provision of the Niue Act 1966.

4 Crimes against premises or vehicles

(1) Without limiting the Niue Act 1966, every one commits a crime who,
whether in or outside Niue, does or omits to do any act –
(a) To, or in relation to –
(i) any premises that he knows to be the official premises or private
residence of any internationally protected person; or
(ii) any vehicle that he knows is used by an internationally
protected person –
while an internationally protected person is present in those
premises or that residence or vehicle; and

Crimes Against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages Act 1984 619

(b) Which constitutes, or would, if done, or omitted to be done in Niue, constitute –
(i) a crime referred to or described in any of the provisions of the
Niue Act 1966 specified in Schedule 2; or
(ii) an attempt to commit any such crime (where the crime is not
itself constituted by a mere attempt).
(2) Every one who commits a crime against this section is liable on
conviction to the same penalty to which he would have been liable had he been
charged with a crime against the relevant provision of the Niue Act 1966.

5 Threats against persons

(1) Every one commits a crime who, whether in or outside Niue, threatens
to do any act –
(a) To, or in relation to, any person whom he knows to be an
internationally protected person; and
(b) Which constitutes a crime against section 3.
(2) Every one commits a crime against this section is liable on conviction
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding the lesser of –
(a) Seven years; or
(b) The term of years prescribed by the relevant provision of the Niue
Act 1966 in respect of the crime that he would have committed had
he carried out his threat in Niue.

6 Threats against premises or vehicles –

(1) Every one commits a crime who, whether in or outside Niue threatens
to do any act –
(a) To, or in relation to –
(i) any premises that he knows to be the official premises or private
residence of any internationally protected person; or
(ii) any vehicle that he knows is used by any internationally
protected person; and
(b) Which constitutes a crime against section 4.
(2) Every one who commits a crime against this section is liable on
conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years.

7 Prosecution need not prove certain matters

Notwithstanding sections 3 to 6, in any proceedings brought under any of
those sections, it shall not be necessary for the prosecution to prove the following
matters:
(a) In respect of any internationally protected person to whom paragraph (a) or paragraph (c) of the definition of that term in section 2(1) applies that the defendant knew, at the time of the alleged crime, the identity of that person or the capacity in which he was an internationally protected person;
(b) In respect of any internationally protected person to whom paragraph (b) of that definition applies, that the defendant knew, at the time of the alleged crime, that the internationally protected person was accompanying any other person to whom paragraph (a) of that definition applies;
(c) In respect of any internationally protected person to whom
paragraph (c) of that definition applies, that the defendant knew, at
the time of the alleged crime, that the internationally protected
person was entitled under international law to special protection
from attack on his person, freedom, or dignity;
620

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(d) In respect of any internationally protected person to whom paragraph (d) of that definition applies, that the defendant knew, at the time of the alleged crime, that the internationally protected person was a member of the household of any other person referred to in paragraph (c) of that definition.

8 Hostage-taking

Hostages

(1) Subject to subsection (2), every one commits the crime of hostage-taking who, whether in or outside Niue, unlawfully seizes or detains any person (in this section called the hostage) without his consent, or with his consent obtained by fraud or duress, with intent to compel the Government of any country or any international intergovernmental organisation or any other person to do or abstain from doing any act as a condition whether express or implied, for the release of the hostage.
(2) No one shall be convicted of the crime of hostage-taking if – (a) The act of hostage-taking takes place in Niue; and
(b) The alleged offender and the hostage are New Zealand citizens;
and
(c) The alleged offender is in Niue.
(3) Every one who commits the crime of hostage-taking is liable on
conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 14 years.

General Provisions

made under section 3 of that Act or referred to in section 21 of that Act –
(a) Each crime described in section 3 or section 4 or section 8 of this
Act, including attempting to commit that crime (where it is not itself
constituted by a mere attempt), aiding, abetting, inciting,
counselling or procuring any person to commit any such crime,
inciting, counselling, or attempting to procure any person to commit
any such crime when it is not in fact committed, and being an
accessory after the fact to that crime; and
(b) Each crime described in section 5 or section 6 of this Act, –
shall, if not already described in the treaty, be deemed to be an offence described
in any extradition treaty concluded before the commencement of this section and
for the time being in force between Niue and any foreign country that is a party to
the 1973 Convention or, as the case may require, the 1979 Convention.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1), no person shall be liable to be
surrendered under the Extradition Act 1965 in respect of an act or omission that
amounts to a crime to which that subsection applies if that act or omission occurred
before the date on which the crime was deemed by that subsection to be an offence
described in the relevant extradition treaty.
(3) For the purposes of this section, “foreign country” includes any territory
for whose international relations the Government of a foreign country is responsible
and to which the extradition treaty and the 1973 Convention or, as the case may
require, the 1979 Convention, extends.

Crimes Against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages Act 1984 621

11 Surrender of offenders

(1) Where the surrender of a person is sought under either the Extradition
Act 1965 or the Fugitive Offenders Act 1881 in respect of any act or omission –
(a) That amounts to –
(i) any crime described in section 3 or section 4 or section 8 of this
Act, including attempting to commit any such crime (where it
is not itself constituted by a mere attempt), aiding, abetting,
inciting, counselling, or procuring any person to commit any
such crime, inciting, counselling, or attempting to procure any
person to commit any such crime when it is not in fact
committed and being an accessory after the fact to any such
crime; or
(ii) any crime described in section 5 or section 6 of this Act; and
(b) For which the person whose surrender is sought could be tried and
punished in the country seeking surrender, being a country that is
a party to the 1973 Convention, or, as the case may require, the 1979
Convention –
that act or omission shall be deemed to have been committed within the jurisdiction
of that country notwithstanding that it was committed outside the territory of
that country.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1) where any act or omission to which
that subsection applies occurred in Niue, the Extradition Act 1965 and the relevant
extradition treaty, or (as the case may require) the Fugitive Offences Act 1881,
shall apply with any necessary modifications as if the act or omission had occurred
outside Niue.
(3) In this section, “country” includes any territory for whose international
relations the Government of a country is responsible and to which the extradition
treaty (if any) and the 1973 Convention or, as the case may be, the 1979 Convention,
extends.

12 Restrictions on surrender of offenders

(1) Notwithstanding sections 9 to 11 of this Act, or the Extradition Act 1965
or the Fugitive Offenders Act 1881, a person whose surrender is sought in respect
of any act or omission that amounts to a crime under section 8 of this Act shall not
be surrendered from Niue to another country if it appears to the Minister of Justice,
or to the Court before which that person is brought, or to any Court or Judge on
an application for a writ of habeas corpus, that –
(a) The surrender of the accused person, although purporting to have
been sought in respect of such a crime, was sought for the purposes
of prosecuting or punishing him on account of his race, ethnic origin,
religion, nationality, or political opinions; or
(b) If the accused person is surrendered –
(i) he may be prejudiced at his trial, or punished, detained, or
restricted in his personal liberty, by reason of his race, ethnic
origin, religion, nationality, or political opinions; or
(ii) his position may be prejudiced because communication with
him by the country that is entitled in international law to
exercise rights of protection in respect to the accused person
cannot be effected.
(2) Notwithstanding sections 9 to 11 of this Act, but without limiting section
6 of the Fugitive Offenders Act 1881, the Minister of Justice may decline under
section 6 to order the surrender of a person from Niue to another Commonwealth
622 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
country in respect of any act or omission that amounts to a crime against any of sections 3 to 8 of this Act if it appears to the Minister that, in respect of the act or omission, the person has been sentenced to death or is liable to be so sentenced by the appropriate authority in the country to which his surrender is sought.
(3) Notwithstanding section 9 to 11 of this Act or section 14 of the Fugitive Offenders Act 1881, no Judge shall without the consent of the Minister of Justice, order the surrender under the said section 14 of a person from Niue to another Commonwealth country in respect of any act or omission that amounts to a crime against any of sections 3 to 8 of this Act if it appears to the Judge that, in respect of the act or omission, the person has been sentenced to death or is liable to be so sentenced by the appropriate authority in the country to which his surrender is sought.

13 Further restrictions on surrender of offender

(1) Notwithstanding sections 9 to 11 of this Act or the Extradition Act 1965
or the Fugitive Offenders Act 1881, no person shall be surrendered from Niue to
another country in respect of any act or omission that amounts to a crime against
any of sections 3 to 8 of this Act if proceedings have been brought in Niue against
that person in respect of the act or omission.
(2) Notwithstanding sections 9 to 11 of this Act or the Extradition Act 1965
or the Fugitive Offenders Act 1881, but subject to subsection (3) of this section, the
High Court of Niue shall not order the surrender, or the committal for the purposes
of surrender, of a person to another country in respect of an act or omission that
amounts to a crime against any of sections 3 to 8 of this Act if the Secretary for
Justice certifies that the case is being or is about to be considered to determine
whether or not proceedings should be brought in Niue against that person in
respect of the act or omission.
(3) If, in any case to which subsection (2) of this section applies, it is
subsequently determined that proceedings should not be brought in Niue against
the person in respect of the act or omission, the Secretary for Justice shall advise
the Court accordingly, and the Court shall proceed with the matter as if the
certificate of the Secretary for Justice had never been given.

14 Consent of Cabinet required to prosecutions

(1) Subject to subsection (2) no proceedings for the trial and punishment
of any person charged with a crime against any of sections 3 to 8 shall be instituted
in any court except with the consent of the Cabinet.
(2) A person charged with a crime against any of those provisions may be
arrested, or a warrant for his arrest may be issued and executed, and he may be
remanded in custody or on bail, notwithstanding that the consent of the Cabinet
to the institution of a prosecution for the crime has not been obtained, but no
further proceedings shall be taken until that consent has been obtained.

15 Evidence

For any purpose in connection with this Act, a certificate, given by the New
Zealand Representative or any other officer of the office of the New Zealand
Representative in Niue, certifying –
(a) Any fact relevant to the question of whether a person was or was
not an internationally protected person at any material time; or
(b) That any country is or is not, or was or was not at any material
time, a party to the 1973 Convention or to the 1979 Convention; or

Crimes Against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages Act 1984 623

(c) That the Government of any country is or is not, or was or was not at any material time, responsible for the international relations of any territory –
shall be sufficient evidence of that fact.
Act 1985, the Aviation Crimes Act 1973, nor, except as expressly provided in this
Act, the Niue Act 1966.

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Section 3 (1)(a)

Crimes Against Internationally Protected Persons

Section of Niue

Act 1966 Subject-matter

162 Rape

162 (3) Attempt to commit rape

134-135 Murder

139 Manslaughter

147 Attempt to murder

148 Conspiracy and inciting to murder

151 Grievous bodily harm

152 Actual bodily harm

157 Assault

160 Abduction of children

236 Accessory after the fact

SCHEDULE 2

Section 4(b)(i)

Crimes Against Premises or Vehicles or Internationally Protected Persons

Section of Niue

Act 1966 Subject-matter

154 Intentionally endangering persons on aerodromes

155 Wantonly endangering persons on or near aerodromes

212 Arson

213 Wilful mischief to property

229 Attempts to commit offences

624 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

625

CROWN PROCEEDINGS ACT 1950

1950/54 – 1 January 1952

1

Short title

20

Recovery of fines imposed otherwise than

2

Interpretation

by judgment or conviction

21

Recovery of debts due upon recognisance

PART 1

22

[Repealed]

SUBSTANTIVE LAW

23

Judgments may be vacated by High Court

3

Claims enforceable by or against the Crown

4

[Repealed]

PART 3

5

Liability of the Crown under other Acts

EXECUTION

6

Liability of the Crown in tort

24

Satisfaction of orders against the Crown

7

Provisions as to industrial property

25

Execution by the Crown

8

Law as to indemnity, contribution, and joint

26

Attachment of money payable by the

and several tortfeasors

Crown

9

[Repealed]

10

Claims in respect of visiting forces

PART 4

11

[Repealed]

MISCELLANEOUS AND SUPPLEMENTAL

Miscellaneous

PART 2

27

Discovery

JURISDICTION, PROCEDURE, AND JUDGMENTS

28

Exclusion of proceedings in rem

12

Civil proceedings by or against the Crown

29

Application of certain provisions

plemental

defence by Crown 35 Saving of certain rights

17 Nature of relief

18 Appeals, stay of execution, and costs SCHEDULES

19 Interest on debts and costs

To consolidate and amend the law relating to the civil liabilities and rights of the Crown and officers of the Crown, and to civil proceedings by and against the Crown

1 Short title

This is the Crown Proceedings Act 1950.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“agent”, in relation to the Crown, includes an independent contractor
employed by the Crown;
“civil proceedings” means any proceedings in any court other than criminal
proceedings; but does not include proceedings in relation to habeas
626

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

corpus, mandamus, prohibition, or certiorari or proceedings by way of an application for judicial review to the extent that any relief sought in the application is in the nature of mandamus, prohibition, or certiorari;
“department” means any department or instrument of the executive government of Niue;
“member of a visiting force” includes a member of any other force who is
attached to a visiting force;
“Niue armed forces” means the Niue Naval Forces, the Niue Army, and
the Niue Air Force;
“officer”, in relation to the Government of Niue, includes any Niue public
servant, a member of Cabinet, and a member of the Niue armed forces,
but does not include the Governor-General or any judicial officer;
“order” includes a judgment, decree, rule, award, or declaration;
“proceedings against the Crown” includes a claim by way of set-off or
counterclaim raised in proceedings by the Crown;
“servant” has the same meaning as officer;
“ship” includes every description of vessel used in navigation not propelled
by oars;
“visiting force” means any naval, military, or air force of any country other
than Niue which has been granted a right of entry into or passage
through or over Niue.
(2) Any reference in this Act to the Crown, in relation to any civil
proceedings, or in relation to any order or judgment debt or costs in connection
with any civil proceedings, shall be construed as including a reference to the
Cabinet or any Government department or officer of the Crown where the Cabinet,
department, or officer is a party or third party to the proceedings under section
14.
(3) The Cabinet shall not be deemed to be the Crown in relation to any proceedings by reason only of the fact that the proceedings are brought by the Cabinet upon the relation of some other person.
PART 1
SUBSTANTIVE LAW

3 Claims enforceable by or against the Crown

(1) (a) All debts, damages, duties, sums of money, land, or goods, due,
payable or belonging to the Crown shall be sued for and recovered
by proceedings taken for that purpose in accordance with this Act.
(b) Nothing in paragraph (a) shall interfere with or restrict any special
power or authority vested in the Crown, or in any person on its
behalf, with respect to all or any of the matters mentioned in
paragraph (a).
(2) Any person may enforce as of right, by civil proceedings taken against
the Crown for that purpose in accordance with this Act, any claim or demand against the Crown in respect of any of the following causes of action –
(a) The breach of any contract or trust;
(b) Any wrong or injury for which the Crown is liable in tort under
any enactment which is binding on the Crown;
(c) Any cause of action, in respect of which a claim or demand may be
made against the Crown under any enactment which is binding on
the Crown, and for which there is not another equally convenient
or more convenient remedy against the Crown;

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

627
(d) Any cause of action, which is independent of contract, trust, or tort, or any Act, for which an action for damages or to recover property of any kind would lie against the Crown if it were a private person of full age and capacity, and for which there is not another equally convenient or more convenient remedy against the Crown.
(3) Any other cause of action in respect of which a petition of right would
lie against the Crown at common law or in respect of which relief would be granted
against the Crown in equity.

4 [Repealed by 2004/270]

5 Liability of the Crown under other Acts

Except as expressly provided by this Act or any other Act, this Act shall not
be construed so as to make any Act binding upon the Crown which would not
otherwise be so binding, or so as to impose any liability of the Crown by virtue of
any Act which is not binding on the Crown.

6 Liability of the Crown in tort

(1) (a) The Crown shall be subject to all those liabilities in tort to which, if
it were a private person of full age and capacity, it would be subject –
(i) in respect of torts committed by its servants or agents;
(ii) in respect of any breach of those duties which a person owes to
his servants or agents at common law by reason of being their
employer; and
(iii) in respect of any breach of the duties attaching at common law
to the ownership, occupation, possession or control of property.
(b) No proceedings shall lie against the Crown by virtue of paragraph
(a) in respect of any act or omission of a servant or agent of the
Crown unless the act or omission would apart from this Act have
given rise to a cause of action in tort against that servant or agent or
his estate.
(2) Where the Crown is bound by a statutory duty which is binding also
on persons other than the Crown and its officers, then, subject to this Act, the
Crown shall, in respect of a failure to comply with that duty, be subject to all those
liabilities in tort (if any) to which it would be so subject if it were a private person
of full age and capacity.
(3) Where any functions are conferred or imposed upon an officer of the
Crown and that officer commits a tort while performing or purporting to perform
those functions, the liabilities of the Crown in respect of the tort shall be such as
they would have been if those functions had been conferred or imposed solely by
virtue of instructions lawfully given by the Crown.
(4) Any enactment which negatives or limits the amount of the liability of
any Government department or officer of the Crown in respect of any tort
committed by that department or officer shall, in the case of proceedings against
the Crown under this section in respect of a tort committed by that department or
officer, apply in relation to the Crown as it would have applied in relation to that
department or officer if the proceedings against the Crown had been proceedings
against that department or officer.
(5) No proceedings shall lie against the Crown by virtue of this section in
respect of anything done or omitted to be done by any person while discharging
or purporting to discharge any responsibilities which he has in connection with
the execution of judicial process.
628 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

7 Provisions as to industrial property

(1) Where an officer or agent of the Government of Niue infringes an
intellectual property right protected by the law of Niue and the infringement is
committed with the authority of the Government, civil proceedings in respect of
the infringement shall lie against the Government under this Act.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) Subject to subsection (1), no proceedings shall lie against the Crown by
virtue of this Act in respect of the infringement of a patent, a registered trade
mark, or of any such copyright as is mentioned in subsection (1).

8 Law as to indemnity, contribution, and joint and several tortfeasors

Where the Crown is subject to any liability by virtue of this Part, the law
relating to indemnity and contribution shall be enforceable by or against the Crown
in respect of the liability to which it is so subject as if the Crown were a private
person of full age and capacity.

9 [Repealed]

10 Claims in respect of visiting forces

(1) Any person who suffers in Niue any damage, loss or injury by, through,
or in connection with the use of any ship, vehicle, or aircraft belonging to any
visiting force, or who has or deems himself to have any just claim or demand in
respect of any cause of action to which this section applies against a member of
any visiting force or a person acting for or on behalf of any visiting force, shall be
entitled to make against the Crown any claim or demand which he would have
been entitled to make under this Part if the ship or vehicle had belonged to the
Crown, or the aircraft had been a service aircraft, or the member or the person so
acting had been a member of the Niue armed forces, and if the Government of the
country to which the visiting force belongs had been the Crown, and for the like
amount (if any) and in the like form and manner as the amount, form, and manner
of the claim or demand that he would have been entitled to make as aforesaid.
(2) This section shall apply to any cause of action which arises in Niue and
which is in respect of the death of or bodily injury to any person or damage to any
property.
(3) In respect of any claim or demand made under this section the Crown
shall have, in relation to the person making it, the same rights and liabilities as the
Crown would have had if the ship or vehicle belonging to the visiting force had
belonged to the Crown or the aircraft belonging to the visiting force had been a
service aircraft, or the member of the visiting force or the person acting for or on
behalf of the visiting force had been a member of the Niue armed forces, as the
case may be.
(4) In the determination of any such claim or demand made by any person
against the Crown, regard shall be had to any payment which that person has
received or is entitled to receive, whether from the Crown or from any other person
or authority, in satisfaction, wholly or partly, of the claim or demand.
(5) For the purposes of this section all persons who, by the law of the
country to which any visiting force belongs, are for the time being subject to the
naval, military, or air force law of that country shall be deemed to be members of
the visiting force.
(6) For the purposes of any proceedings to enforce a claim or demand made
under this section, a certificate issued by or on behalf of such authority as may be
appointed for the purpose by the Government of the country to which any visiting

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

629
force belongs stating that a person of the name and description specified in the certificate is, or was at a time so specified, subject to the naval, military, or air force law of that country shall be conclusive evidence of that fact.
(7) If in any proceedings as aforesaid the question is raised whether any person whose name appears in or in connection with the proceedings is or was at any time a member of any visiting force, any such certificate as aforesaid relating to a person bearing that name shall, unless the contrary is proved, be deemed to relate to that person.
(8) Any document purporting to be a certificate issued for the purposes of
this section and to be signed by or on behalf of an authority described as appointed
by the Government of any country for the purposes of this section shall be received
in evidence and shall, unless the contrary is proved, be deemed to be a certificate
issued by or on behalf of an authority so appointed.

11 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 2
JURISDICTION, PROCEDURE, AND JUDGMENTS

12 Civil proceedings by or against the Crown

All civil proceedings which must be taken by, or may be brought against,
the Crown under this Act may be commenced, heard, and determined in the same
Court and in like manner in all respects as in suits between subject and subject.

13 Interpleader

Without limiting any other provisions of this Act, it is hereby declared that
the Crown may obtain relief by way of interpleader proceedings, and may be
made a party to such proceedings, in the manner in which a subject may obtain
relief by way of such proceedings or be made a party to it, and may be made a
party to such proceedings notwithstanding that the application for relief is made
by a sheriff or bailiff or other like officer; and all rules of Court relating to
interpleader proceedings shall, subject to this Act, have effect accordingly.

14 Method of making Crown a party to proceedings

(1) Civil proceedings under this Act by the Crown may be instituted by –
(a) The appropriate Government department in its own name if the
department has power to sue apart from this section; or
(b) The appropriate officer of the Crown in the name in which he may
sue on behalf of the Crown or of any Government department if
the officer has power to sue on behalf of the Crown or of any
Government department apart from this section; or
(c) The Cabinet, if there is no such appropriate department or officer
or if the Cabinet has any reasonable doubt whether any and, if so,
which department or officer is appropriate; or
(d) Any 2 or more of them jointly.
(2) Civil proceedings under this Act against the Crown shall be instituted
against –
(a) The appropriate Government department in its own name if the department may be sued apart from this section; or
(b) The appropriate officer of the Crown in the name in which he may be sued on behalf of the Crown or of any Government department if the officer may be sued on behalf of the Crown or of any Government department apart from this section; or
630 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(c) The Cabinet if there is no such appropriate department or officer or if the person instituting the proceedings has any reasonable doubt whether any and, if so, which Department or officer is appropriate; or
(d) Any 2 or more of them jointly.
(3) The Crown may be joined as a plaintiff to any civil proceedings to which
it could be a plaintiff under this Act by joining as a plaintiff –
(a) Any Government department by which, or officer of the Crown by
whom, the proceedings could be instituted under subsection (1); or
(b) The Cabinet if there is no such department or officer or if the person
seeking to join the Crown as a plaintiff has any reasonable doubt
whether any and, if so, which department or officer should be so
joined; or
(c) Any 2 or more of them jointly.
(4) The Crown may be joined as a defendant or third party to any civil
proceedings to which it could be a defendant under this Act by joining as a
defendant or third party –
(a) Any Government department against which, or officer of the Crown
against whom, the proceedings could be instituted under subsection
2; or
(b) The Cabinet if there is no such department or officer or if the person
seeking to join the Crown as a defendant or third party has any
reasonable doubt whether any and, if so, which department or
officer should be so joined; or
(c) Any 2 or more of them jointly.
(5) (a) Where any civil proceedings against the Crown under this Act are
instituted against the Cabinet or the Cabinet is joined as a party or
third party to any such proceedings, an application may at any stage
of the proceedings be made to the Court by or on behalf of the
Cabinet to have one or more of the Government departments or
officers of the Crown against which or against whom the
proceedings could have been instituted under subsection (2),
substituted for it as a party or third party to the proceedings; and
where any such proceedings are brought against any such
department or officer, or where any such department or officer is
joined as a party or third party to any such proceedings, an
application may at any stage of the proceedings be made to the
Court on behalf of the department or officer to have the Cabinet or
any such department or officer substituted for the applicant as a
party or third party to the proceedings.
(b) Upon any such application the Court may make an order granting
the application on such terms as the Court thinks just, and the
proceedings shall continue accordingly.
(6) No proceedings instituted under this Act to which the Cabinet or any
Government department or officer of the Crown is a party or third party shall
abate or be affected by any change in the person holding the office of a Minister or
any other office in the Government service or in the person or body of persons
constituting the department.
(7) Where the Cabinet or any Government department or officer of the
Crown is a party or third party to any proceedings under this section, any order of
the Court against or in favour of the Crown in those proceedings shall be made
against or in favour of the Cabinet or the department or officer as the case may be.

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

15 [Repealed by 2004/270]

631

16 Service of documents and time for filing defence by Crown

(1) In any civil proceedings instituted against the Cabinet or to which the
Cabinet is joined as a party or third party, as aforesaid, the first document required
to be served on him, and any other document required to be served before an
address for service has been given by him shall be served on the Cabinet by
delivering it to the Registrar of the High Court of Niue or by leaving at the office
of the Registrar at his said office or by sending it by post in a registered letter
addressed to the Registrar of the High Court at his said office.
(2) In any civil proceedings against the Crown under this Act the time to
be allowed in any writ or summons for the filing of a statement of defence or
notice of intention to defend shall be not less than 28 days, or such further time as
the Court may allow.
(3) Where any document is sent by post in the manner prescribed by
subsection (1) it shall be deemed to have been served at the time at which the
letter would have been delivered in the ordinary course of post.

17 Nature of relief

(1) In any civil proceedings under this Act by or against the Crown or to
which the Crown is a party or third party the Court shall have power to make all
such orders as it has power to make in proceedings between subjects, and otherwise
to give such appropriate relief as the case may require.
(2) (a) Where in any proceedings against the Crown any such relief is
sought as might in proceedings between subjects be granted by way
of injunction or specific performance, the Court shall not grant an
injunction or make an order for specific performance, but may
instead make an order declaratory of the rights of the parties.
(b) In any proceedings against the Crown for the recovery of land or
other property, the Court shall not make an order for the recovery
of the land or delivery of the property, but may instead make an
order declaring that any person is entitled as against the Crown to
the land or property or to the possession of it.
(3) The Court shall not in any civil proceedings grant any injunction or
make any order against an officer of the Crown if the effect of granting the
injunction or making the order would be to give any relief against the Crown
which could not have been obtained in proceedings against the Crown.

18 Appeals, stay of execution, and costs

(1) Subject to this Act, all enactments and rules of court relating to appeals
and stay of execution shall, with any necessary modifications, apply to civil
proceedings by or against the Crown under this Act as they apply to proceedings
between subjects; and the costs of suit shall follow on either side as in ordinary
cases between other suitors.
(2) The Crown shall not be required under any rule of court or order to
deposit or give security for the costs of any other party.

19 Interest on debts and costs

(1) Any judgment debt due from or to the Crown shall carry interest if it
would carry interest if it were due from or to a subject, and any interest so payable
shall be at the rate at which it would be payable if the judgment debt were due
from or to a subject.
632 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) Any costs awarded to or against the Crown shall carry interest if the costs would carry interest if they were awarded to or against a subject, and any interest so payable shall be at the rate at which it would be payable by a subject. (3) Any judgment in any civil proceedings by or against the Crown may
award interest to any party to whom interest could be awarded if the proceedings were between subjects at the rate at which interest could be so awarded.

20 Recovery of fines imposed otherwise than by judgment or conviction

(1) Notwithstanding sections 2 to 19 where a fine is imposed upon any
person otherwise than by a judgment or conviction of some court, and no other
procedure is provided by any Act or rule of court for the recovery of the fine, the
court by which the fine was imposed shall, if the same is not immediately paid, by
writing in the form numbered (1) in Schedule 3, certify the fact, together with the
name and place of abode or business, of the person on whom the fine was imposed,
and the cause and amount of the fine, and shall deliver or send by post the writing
to the Cabinet who, upon receipt of it, shall cause a final judgment to be signed in
the High Court for the amount of the fine, and a sum not exceeding 10 dollars for
costs.
(2) Every such judgment may be in the form numbered (2) in Schedule 3 or to the like effect, and no appeal shall lie therefrom.

21 Recovery of debts due upon recognisance

(1) Notwithstanding sections 2 to 20 where any person has entered into a
recognisance to Her Majesty, and the recognisance is forfeited, and no other
procedure is provided by any Act or rule of Court for the estreat thereof, the Court
before which, the same was forfeited may cause the recognisance to be estreated
as provided in this section.
(2) The Judge shall, by writing under his hand in the form numbered (3) in
Schedule 3, or to the like effect, certify that the forfeiture has taken place, and shall
deliver or send by post the said recognisance and writing to the Cabinet who,
upon receipt of it shall cause a final judgment to be signed in the High Court for
the amount of the recognisance and a sum not exceeding 10 dollars for costs.
(3) Every such judgment may be in the form numbered (4) in Schedule 3
or to the like effect, and no appeal shall lie therefrom.
the High Court may order satisfaction to be entered upon the judgment, whether execution has been issued on it or not.
(2) Such an order shall not be made except upon notice calling upon the Cabinet to show cause, nor unless it is proved by affidavit to the satisfaction of the High Court either that the judgment has been satisfied, or that, according to equity and good conscience and the real merits and justice of the case, the defendant ought not to be required to satisfy the same.

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

633
PART 3
EXECUTION

24 Satisfaction of orders against the Crown

(1) Except as provided in this section, no execution or attachment or process
in the nature of it shall be issued out of any court for enforcing satisfaction by the
Crown, or by the Cabinet or any Government department or officer of the Crown
of any order made in any civil proceedings under this Act.
(2) (a) Where in any civil proceedings any order (whether for costs or
otherwise) is made by the court in favour of any person against the
Crown or the Cabinet or any Government department or officer of
the Crown, and the person in whose favour the order is made so
requests, the proper officer of the court shall issue to that person,
without payment of any fee, a certificate in the form numbered (5)
in Schedule 3 or to the like effect.
(b) If the order provides for the payment of money, the court by which
the order is made or any court to which an appeal against the order
lies direct that, pending an appeal or otherwise, payment of the
money so payable, or any part of it shall be suspended, and (if the
certificate has not been issued) may order any such directions to be
inserted in it.
(3) On receipt of any such certificate the Treasurer without further
appropriation than this section, may cause to be paid to the person named in it
the amount payable by the Crown under the order, together with any costs allowed
him by the Court and the interest, if any, lawfully due and may also perform or
give effect to the terms of the order so far as it is to be satisfied by the Crown.
(4) The Minister of Finance shall, forthwith after the end of each financial
year, cause to be prepared, in such form as he approves or directs, a statement
showing all amounts paid under this section without appropriation other than
this section; and shall, as soon as practicable, cause the statement (duly audited
by the Audit Office) to be laid before the Assembly.

25 Execution by the Crown

(1) Any order made in favour of the Crown against any person in any civil
proceedings may be enforced in the same manner as an order made between
subjects is enforced, and not otherwise.
(2) Nothing in this section shall affect any procedure which immediately
before the commencement of the Act was available for enforcing an order made in
favour of the Crown in proceedings brought by the Crown for the forfeiture or
condemnation of any goods, or the forfeiture of any ship or any share in a ship.

26 Attachment of money payable by the Crown

(1) Any person who has obtained an order for the payment of money may
take proceedings under rules of court, to obtain payment to him of the amount of
any debt payable by or accruing due from the Crown to the person against whom
the order was made, or so much thereof as may be sufficient to satisfy the order
and the costs of the garnishee proceedings; and in any such case the court may
make any order in respect of the amount payable by or accruing due from the
Crown which it would be entitled to make if the whole proceedings were between
subjects.
(2) Except as provided in any other Act, no such order shall be made in
respect of –
634 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(a) Any wages, salary, honorarium, allowances, or expenses payable to any officer of the Crown as such;
(b) Any money which is subject to the provisions of any enactment prohibiting or restricting assignment or charging or taking in execution.

27 Discovery

PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS AND SUPPLEMENTAL

Miscellaneous

(1) Subject to and under rules of court –
(a) In any civil proceedings to which the Crown is a party or third
party, the Crown may be required by the court to answer
interrogatories if the Crown could be required to do so if it were a
private person of full age and capacity; and
(b) In any such proceedings as aforesaid the Crown may be required
by the Court to make discovery of documents and produce
documents for inspection if the Crown could be required to do so if
it were a private person of full age and capacity.
(2) This section shall be without prejudice to any rule of law which
authorises or requires the withholding of any document or the refusal to answer
any question on the ground that the disclosure of the document or the answering
of the question would be injurious to the public interest.
(3) Any order of the Court made under subsection (1)(a) shall direct by
what officer of the Crown the interrogatories are to be answered.
(4) Without prejudice to subsection (2) any rules made for the purposes of
this section shall be such as to secure that the existence of a document will not be
disclosed if, in the opinion of the Cabinet, it would be injurious to the public
interest to disclose its existence.

28 Exclusion of proceedings in rem

(1) Nothing in this Act shall authorise proceedings in rem in respect of any
claim against the Crown, or the arrest, detention or sale of any ships or aircraft, or
any cargo or other property belonging to Her Majesty, whether in right of the
Government in Niue or otherwise, or give to any person any lien on any such
ship, aircraft, cargo, or other property.
(2) (a) Where proceedings in rem have been instituted in the High Court
against any such ship, aircraft, cargo, or other property, the Court
may, if satisfied, either on an application by the plaintiff for an order
under this subsection or on application by the Crown to set aside
the proceedings, that the proceedings were so instituted by the
plaintiff in the reasonable belief that the ship, aircraft, cargo, or other
property did not belong to the Crown, order that the proceedings
shall be treated as if they were in personam duly instituted against
the Crown under this Act, or duly instituted against any other
person whom the Court regards as the proper person to be sued in
the circumstances, and that the proceedings shall continue
accordingly.
(b) Any such order may be made upon such terms, if any, as the Court
thinks just; and, where the Court makes any such order, it may
make such consequential orders as the Court thinks expedient.

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

635

29 Application of certain provisions

This Act shall not prejudice the right of the Crown to take advantage of an
Act although not named therein; and it is hereby declared that in any civil
proceedings against the Crown any Act which could, if the proceedings were
between subjects, be relied upon by the defendant as a defence to the proceedings,
whether in whole or in part, or otherwise, may, subject to any express provision to
the contrary, be so relied upon by the Crown.

30 Rules of court

Supplemental

(1) Any power to make, alter, or revoke rules touching or regulating the practice and procedure of any court shall include power to make, alter, or revoke rules for the purpose of giving effect to this Act, and any such rules may contain provisions to have effect in relation to any proceedings by or against the Crown in substitution for or by way of addition to any of the provisions of the rules applying to proceedings between subjects.
(2) Without prejudice to the generality of subsection (1), rules may be made with respect to the following matters –
(a) For providing for service outside Niue of process or notice of it, in the case of proceedings by the Crown;
(b) For securing that where any civil proceedings are brought against
the Crown under this Act the plaintiff shall, before the Crown is
required to take any steps in the proceedings, provide the Crown
with such information as the Crown may reasonably require as to
the circumstances in which it is alleged that the liability of the Crown
has arisen and as to the departments and officers of the Crown
concerned;
(c) For providing that in the case of proceedings against the Crown
the plaintiff shall not enter judgment in default of appearance or
pleading without the leave of the court to be obtained on an
application of which notice has been given to the Crown;
(d) For excepting proceedings brought against the Crown from the
operation of any rule of court providing for summary judgment
without trial;
(e) For providing that a person shall not be entitled to avail himself of
any set-off or counterclaim in any proceedings by the Crown for
the recovery of taxes, duties, or penalties, or to avail himself in
proceedings of any other nature by the Crown of any set-off or
counterclaim arising out of a right or claim to repayment in respect
of any taxes, duties, or penalties;
(f) For providing that a person shall not be entitled, without the leave
of the court, to avail himself of any set-off or counterclaim in any
proceedings by the Crown if either the subject-matter of the set-off
or counterclaim does not relate to the Government department or
officer of the Crown in whose name the proceedings are brought or
the proceedings are brought in the name of the Cabinet;
(g) For providing that the Crown, when sued in the name of a
Government department or of an officer of the Crown, shall not,
without the leave of the court, be entitled to avail itself of any set­
off or counterclaim if the subject-matter of it does not relate to that
department or officer; and
636 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(h) For providing that the Crown, when sued in the name of the Cabinet shall not be entitled to avail itself of any set-off or counterclaim without the leave of the court.

31 General rules

The laws, statutes, and rules for the time being in force as to pleading,
joinder of parties, third party procedure, evidence, hearing and trial, amendment,
arbitration, special cases, the means of procuring and taking evidence, set-off,
appeal, and all other laws, statutes, and rules for the time being available as between
plaintiffs and defendants in personal actions between subjects, and the practice
and course of procedure of the court in its legal and equitable jurisdiction
respectively for the time being in reference to such suits and personal actions,
shall, unless the court otherwise orders, be applicable, and apply and extend to
civil proceedings by or against the Crown.

32-34 [Spent]

35 Saving of certain rights

(1) Nothing in this Act shall apply to or authorise proceedings by or against
Her Majesty in her private capacity.
(2) Except as expressly provided in this Act, nothing in this Act shall–
(a) Affect the law relating to prize salvage, or apply to proceedings in
causes or matters within the jurisdiction of the High Court as a
Prize Court, or to any criminal proceedings; or
(b) Authorise proceedings to be taken against the Crown under or in
accordance with this Act in respect of any alleged liability of the
Crown arising otherwise than in respect of the Government in Niue
or affect proceedings against the Crown in respect of any such
alleged liability as aforesaid; or
(c) Affect any proceedings by the Crown otherwise than in right of the
Government in Niue; or
(d) Subject the Crown to any greater liabilities in respect of the acts or
omissions of any independent contractor employed by the Crown
than those to which the Crown would be subject in respect of the
acts or omissions if the Crown were a private person; or
(e) Subject the Crown to any liability in respect of the acts or omissions
of any medical practitioner, pharmaceutical chemist, midwife,
maternity nurse, dentist, or any other person while any such person
is rendering any professional or other service or supplying any
medicine, drug, appliance unless the medical practitioner,
pharmaceutical chemist, midwife, maternity nurse, dentist or other
person is acting as a servant of the Crown at the time of the act or
omission; or
(f) Subject the Crown, in its capacity as a highway authority, to any
greater liability than that to which a local authority is subject in
that capacity; or
(g) Interfere with or affect any Act that now is or hereafter may be in
force whereby the Crown, or any of its officers and servants, is
exempt from liability for anything done under the Act or affect any
power, authority, or liability vested in or imposed upon the Crown
or any of its officers or servants under any such Act; or

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

637
(h) Affect any right of the Crown to control or otherwise intervene in proceedings affecting the Crown’s rights, property, or profits.
(3) A certificate of the Cabinet –
(a) To the effect that any alleged liability of the Crown arises otherwise
than in respect of Government in Niue; or
(b) To the effect that any proceedings by the Crown are proceedings
otherwise than in right of the Government in Niue –
shall for the purposes of this Act, be conclusive as to the matter so certified.
(4) Where any property vests in the Crown by virtue of any rule of law
which operates independently of the acts or the intentions of the Crown, the Crown
shall not by virtue of this Act be subject to any liabilities in tort by reason only of
the property being so vested; but this subsection shall be without prejudice to the
liabilities of the Crown under this Act in respect of any period after the Crown or
any person acting for the Crown has in fact taken possession or control of any
such property, or entered into occupation thereof.
(5) This Act shall not operate to limit the discretion of the Court to grant
relief by way of mandamus in cases in which such relief might have been granted
before the commencement of this Act, notwithstanding that by reason of the
provisions of this Act some other and further remedy is available.

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Section 5(2)

Enactments to Bind the Crown

Bills of Exchange Act 1908

Mercantile Law Act 1908: Part 2

Interpretation Act 2004

Sea Carriage of Goods Act 1940

SCHEDULE 2 [Repealed by 2004/270]

638 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

SCHEDULE 3

Section 20(1)

(1) CERTIFICATE OF FINE

This is to certify to the Cabinet that, at the this day held at , the several persons whose names and places of abode or business are specified in the Schedule below were fined the several sums therein set opposite to their respective names, and that the cause of each such fine is duly and truly set forth in the said Schedule.

Schedule

Full name Place of Abode of Business

Cause of Fine Amount

Behaving and con­

ducting himself in

a disorderly manner

in Court

£ s d

Total £

Given under my hand this day of 20 . Judge.

Section 20 (2)

(2) JUDGMENT IN RESPECT OF FINE

In the High Court at No.

Be it remembered that the Registrar of the High Court has informed the Court that at the

held at on

the day of , 20 , before a

fine of was imposed and inflicted upon

because he, the said (behaved and conducted himself in a

disorderly manner in the said Court, or as the case may be) as by the

certificate of the said now filed of record appears. Therefore,

on the day of , 20 , it is adjudged

by the Court here that the Crown do recover against the said

the sum of and also the sum of

for costs, making together the sum of .

Dated at this day of 20 .

Registrar.

Section 21 (2)

(3) CERTIFICATE OF FORFEITURE OF RECOGNISANCE

This is to certify to the Cabinet of Ministers that, at the

this day held at the recognisances hereunto annexed

were forfeited, and were there and then caused to be estreated.

Given under my hand this day of 20 .

Judge, Commissioner.

In the High Court at

Crown Proceedings Act 1950

Section 21 (3)

(4) JUDGMENT IN RESPECT OF RECOGNISANCE

639

Be it remembered that the Registrar of the High Court has informed the Court that at the held at on

the day of

20 , before the recognisance of one , by which he acknowledged to

owe to the Crown the sum of , was forfeited and estreated as by the said

recognisance and the certificate of the said

now filed or record appears. Therefore, on the day of

, 20 , it is adjudged by the Court here that the Crown

do recover against the said the said sum of ,

and also the sum of for costs, making together the sum of

Dated at this day of 20 .

Registrar.

Section 24(2)

(5) CERTIFICATE OF JUDGMENT, ETC.

In the High Court at

Between , plaintiff, and , Defendant.

I hereby certify that , of , did on the

day of 20 , in the High Court at

, obtain a judgment

(order, decree, or declaration); and that by the judgment (order, decree, or declaration)

the Crown was ordered to pay to him the sum of (or as the case may be).

Dated at this day of 20 .

Registrar.

640 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

641

CUSTOMS ACT 1966

1966/19 – 1 January 1967

32A Customs container bases

33 Duties of controlling authorities

34 Storage charges

35 Security

12-13 [Repealed]

14 Charges in respect of attendance of officers

15 Districts

PART 2

CONTROL OF THE CUSTOMS, GENERAL PROVISIONS AS

TO ENTRIES

Control of the Customs

16 Control of the Customs

17 Delivery for home consumption

18 No responsibility for safe custody of goods

General Provisions as to Entries

19 Making of entries

20 Verification of entries

21 Erroneous entries

22 Passing of entries

23 Cancellation and amendment of entry

24 Amendment of entries by officers

25 Goods to be dealt with according to entry

PART 3

IMPORTATION, EXPORTATION, REMOVAL WITHIN NIUE

Ports of Entry, Customs Airports

26 Ports of entry

27 Boarding stations

28 Wharves

29 Sufferance wharves

30 Customs airports

31 Examination stations at Customs airports

32 Examining places

Arrival of Ships and Aircraft

36 Ships to come into port of entry only

37 Aircraft to land at Customs airport only

38 Aircraft landing other than at Customs

airport

39 Transshipment of goods

40 Interference with cargo

41 Boarding of ships at sea

42 Boarding of ships at boarding stations

43 Stations of ships

44 Aircraft brought to examination station

45 Inward report

46 Report of wrecked ships and aircraft

Importation

47 “Importation” defined

48 Prohibited imports

49 Importation of brandy, whisky and rum

50 Goods not to be landed or dealt with

without permission

51 [Repealed]

52 Method of unshipment

52A Removal of goods

52B Manager ’s permits

53 Kinds of entry of imported goods

54 Passengers’ effects exempt from entry

54A Certain goods exempt from entry

55 When entry to be made

56 Vessels or aircraft imported

57 Licence or permit for restricted goods

58 Sight entries

59 Delivery of goods on sight entry

60 Goods for home consumption

61 Importer may be required to furnish

samples and illustrations

Removal within Niue Exportation

62 Removal of imported goods within Niue

63 Export subject to control of Customs

642 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

64 Entry for export of goods not subject to control of Customs

65 Method of shipment

66 Goods not shipped according to entry

67 Information and securities in respect of

exported goods

68 Exported goods not to be relanded

69 Time of exportation

70 Prohibited exports

71 Ships in which goods may be exported

Departure of Ships and Aircraft

72 Clearance of ships and aircraft

73 Report outwards

74 Entitlement to clearance

75 Boarding of outward ships and aircraft

76 Production of clearance

77 Departure to be from port of entry or

Customs airport only

Stores for Ships and Aircraft

78 Stores exempt from duty

79 Stores subject to duty

105 Temporary removal of warehoused goods

106 Liability for duty on missing goods

Clearance of Warehoused Goods

107 Kinds of entry of warehoused goods

108 Entry for home consumption

109 Entry for export

110 Entry for removal

111 Constructive warehousing

112 Rewarehousing

Crown Warehouses

113 Crown warehouses

114 Charges in Crown warehouses

115 Warehousing in Crown warehouses

116 Licensed warehouses

Special Provisions as to Manufacturing

Warehouses

117-117A [Repealed]

118 Penalties for wrongful use of

manufacturing warehouse

PART 5

PART 4

WAREHOUSES

Licensed Warehouses

80 Licensing of warehouses

81 Application for licence

82 Security for warehouse

83 Grant of licence

84 Harbour Boards and local authorities may

hold licences

85 Licence fees

86 [Repealed]

87 Termination of licence

88 Cancellation of licence

89 Transfer of licence

90 Surrender of licence

91 Closing of warehouse

92 Use of manufacturing warehouses

93 Structural alterations of warehouse

Warehousing of Goods

94 Entry for warehousing

95 Account of warehoused goods

96 Receipt for warehoused goods

97 Removal of goods to warehouse

98 Packing of warehoused goods

99 Repacking of warehoused goods

100 Duties of licensee

101 Access of officers of Customs to warehouse

102 Restriction on right of warehousing

103 Sale of goods on which dues in arrear

104 Goods not to be removed without

permission

119-135 [Repealed]

Valuation of Goods

136 “Current domestic value” defined

137 Production of invoice

138 “Invoice” defined

139 Blank invoices

140 Valuation of goods by Collector

141 Valuation presumed to be correct

142 Appeal to Minister from valuation

143 Invoices in foreign currency

144 Country of export

145 Current domestic value of goods imported

through intermediate country

146 Valuation for assessment of duties

147 Crown’s right of compulsory purchase

Origin of Imported Goods

148 Determining country of origin

149 Importer to state country of origin

150 Entry of goods at preferential rates

151 Goods subject to forfeiture in case of false

declaration

Assessment and Recovery of Duty

152 Duty on imported goods a Crown debt

153 Duty on goods produced in

manufacturing warehouse a Crown debt

154 Duty a charge on goods

155 Goods not to be delivered till duty paid

156 Payment of duty by one person not to

affect liability of other persons

Customs Act 1966

643

157 Incidence of altered duties

158-159 [Repealed]

160 Assessment of duty in particular cases

161 Alteration of goods

162 Minimum duty collectable

163 Essences and other preparations

164 Reimportation of goods

165 [Repealed]

166 [Repealed]

167 Power to suspend excise duties on goods

supplied to certain organisations

168 Samples of goods

169 Duties on wrecked goods

170 Liability of owners of ships or aircraft for

duty on missing goods

Refunds and Remissions of Duty

171 Recovery of duty paid in error

172 Secretary may refund duty paid in error

172A Secretary may refund duty on forfeited

goods

173 Remission or refund of duty on damaged

and faulty goods

174 Remission of duty on warehoused goods

diminished in value

175 Remission or refund of duty on goods

destroyed, pillaged, or lost

176 Remission or refund of duty on goods

produced in a manufacturing warehouse

177 Remission of duty on goods not worth

the duty

178 Duty on goods from countries not

forming part of the Commonwealth

179 Duty may be reduced or remitted where

prices of Niue goods increased

180 Refund of duty on materials used in

manufacture of agricultural implements,

machinery, ships and boats

181 Duty on goods temporarily imported

182 Recovery of duty refunded in error

Drawbacks

183 Drawbacks of duty on goods exported

184 Entry for exportation under drawback

185 Reimportation of goods exported under

drawback

186 [Repealed]

PART 6

PART 8

POWERS OF OFFICERS OF CUSTOMS

203 Examination of goods

204 Examination of goods no longer under

control of Customs

205 Boarding of ships and aircraft

206 Searching of ships and aircraft

207 Boarding and searching Her Majesty’s

ships and aircraft

208 Firing on ships

209 Securing goods on ships and aircraft

210 Patrolling sea coast and aerodromes

211 Mooring vessels of Customs

212 Questioning persons

213 Searching persons

214 Examining goods carried by persons

215 Searching vehicles or boats

216 Customs warrants

217 Entry and search under Customs warrant

218 Requisition to produce documents

219 Documents in foreign language

220 Impounding documents

221 Taking samples

222 Permitting examination of goods

223 Mode of exercising power of sale

224 Duty payable on goods sold by Manager

225 Sale of forfeited goods

226 Payments by Manager

227 Expenses of removal and storage of

goods by officers of Customs

228 Reasonable and probable cause

228A Protection of persons acting under

authority of Act

PART 9

SECURITIES

229 Securities for payment of duty and

compliance with Act

230 New securities may be required

PART 10

AGENTS AND CARRIERS

Customs Agents

231 Who may act as agent

232 Licensing of Customs agents

233 Written authority of agents

234 Liability of principal for acts of agent

235 Liability of agents

187-193 [Repealed]

194-202 [Repealed]

PART 7

Customs Carriers

236 Conveyance of goods subject to the

control of the Customs

237 [Repealed]

644 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

PART 11

OFFENCES

Offences in Relation to Officers

238 Influencing or resisting officer

239 Obstructing officers of Customs

240 Abusive or threatening language

241 Personation of officer of Customs

Other Offences

242 Smuggling

243 Defrauding the revenue of Customs

244 Erroneous drawbacks or refunds

245 Erroneous declarations

246 Wilfully false declarations

247 Production of false documents

248 Interference with goods

248A Unauthorised entry into passenger

processing areas

249 Ship or aircraft used for smuggling

250 Ships and aircraft adapted for smuggling

251 Counterfeit seals or marks

252 Failure to comply with conditions of

entry

253 Possession or custody of uncustomed

goods or prohibited imports

254 Possession of concealed goods

255 Failure to answer questions truly

256 Liability of officers of body corporate

257 Attempts

General Provisions as to Offences

258 Offences punishable on summary

conviction

259 Information to be laid by Manager

260 Procedure

261 Value of goods for purpose of fine

262 General penalty

263 Imprisonment for second offence

264 Court may order payment of money in

respect of duty

265 Penalties independent of forfeitures

266 Power of Manager to deal with petty

offences

267 Arrest of offenders

Rewards

268 Rewards for seizures and convictions

PART 12

FORFEITURES

269 Application of this Part

Forfeiture

270 Goods forfeited

271 Forfeiture of packages

272 Boats and vehicles forfeited

273 Equipment of forfeited boats, vehicles

and animals

274 Forfeiture to relate back

Seizure

275 Seizure of forfeited goods

276 Where goods may be seized

277 Rescue of seized goods

278 Notice of seizure

Condemnation

279 Condemnation without suit

280 Condemnation by High Court

281 No other action competent while

condemnation proceedings pending

282 [Repealed]

283 Conviction to operate as a condemnation

of forfeited goods

Miscellaneous Provisions

284 Delivery of goods seized on deposit of

value

285 Sale of perishable articles seized

286 Disposal of forfeited goods

287 [Repealed]

288 Application of forfeiture provisions

PART 13

DETENTION OF SHIPS AND AIRCRAFT

289 Ships and aircraft liable to detention

290 Seizure of ships and aircraft

291 Where ships and aircraft may be seized

292 Rescue of seized ships and aircraft

293 Security to be given before release of

seized ship or aircraft

294 Avoidance of security

295 Enforcement of security

296 Service of process

PART 14

EVIDENCE

297 Incriminating questions and documents

298 Source of information need not be

disclosed

299 Burden of proof

300 Burden of proof of justification

301 Presumption of authenticity of

documents

302 What evidence receivable

303 Declarations under this Act

PART 15

COOK ISLANDS AND NIUE

304 Goods may be imported from Cook

Islands and New Zealand

Customs Act 1966

645

PART 16

305

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

Goods passing through Post Office

308 Regulations

309-313 [Repealed]

306

Regulations

307 Penalties imposed by regulations SCHEDULES

To consolidate and amend certain enactments relating to customs and excise and to the importation and exportation of goods

1 Short title

This is the Customs Act 1966.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“aerodrome” means any defined area of land or water intended or designed
to be used either wholly or partly for the landing, departure, movement,
and servicing of aircraft; and includes any buildings, installations, and
equipment on or adjacent to any such area used in connection with the
aerodrome or its administration;
“aircraft” means any machine that can derive support in the atmosphere
from the reaction of the air;
“boat” means any vessel other than a ship;
“bulk cargo container” means an article of transport equipment, being a
lift van, movable tank, or other similar structure –
(a) Of a permanent character and accordingly strong enough to be
suitable for repeated used; and
(b) Specially designed to facilitate the carriage of goods by one or more
modes of transport, without immediate repacking; and
(c) Fitted with devices permitting its ready handling and its transfer
from one mode of transport to another; and
(d) So designed as to be easy to fill and empty; and
(e) Having an internal volume of one cubic metre or more –
and includes the normal accessories and equipment of the container,
when imported with the container and used exclusively with it; but
does not include any vehicle, or any ordinary packing case, crate, box,
or other similar article used for packing;
“controlling authority” in relation to any wharf, customs airport, examining
place, or customs containerbase, means the owner or occupier thereof,
or any person having the control thereof; and includes any Harbour
Board or local authority or public body having the control thereof;
“Customs” means the Customs Department;
“customs airport” means any aerodrome appointed as a customs airport
under section 30;
“customs containerbase” means a place appointed under this Act for the
reception, examination, or protection of goods subject to the control of
the Customs and carried or to be carried in bulk cargo containers;
“declaration” means a declaration made under this Act;
“documents” includes books;
“dutiable goods” means goods of a kind subject to duty on their importation
or on their manufacture in a manufacturing warehouse or on their entry
for home consumption;
646 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“duty” means any duty payable on goods on the importation thereof, and includes duty payable under this Act on goods produced in a manufacturing warehouse;
“examination station” means a place at a Customs airport appointed by the Secretary as an examination station under this Act;
“examining place” means a place appointed under this Act for the
examination by the Customs of goods subject to the control of the
Customs;
“forfeited goods” means any goods in respect of which a cause of forfeiture
has arisen under the Customs Acts;
“goods” means all kinds of movable personal property, including animals;
“importer” means any person by or for whom any goods are imported;
and includes the consignee of any goods and any person who is or
becomes the owner of or entitled to the possession of or beneficially
interested in any goods on or at any time after their importation and
before they have ceased to be subject to the control of the Customs;
“intent to defraud the revenue of Customs” means –
(a) An intent to evade or to enable any other person to evade payment
of the duty or any part of the duty payable on any goods; or
(b) An intent to obtain or to enable any other person to obtain, in respect
of any goods, any drawback or refund of duty not authorised by
law or in excess of that which is authorised by law; or
(c) An intent to evade or to enable any other person to evade payment
of any money payable to the Crown under this Act;
“Manager” means any officer appointed as Revenue Manager at any port
or in respect of any district; and includes the Financial Secretary; and
also includes the chief officer of Customs at any port or other place,
and any proper officer acting for the time being in place of the Manager
either generally or in respect of any of his powers or functions, whether
during any vacancy in the office of Manager or otherwise;
“manufacture”, in relation to tobacco, includes the processes of cutting,
pressing, grinding, crushing, or rubbing any raw or leaf tobacco, or
otherwise preparing raw or leaf tobacco or manufactured or partially
manufactured tobacco, and of making cigarettes whether from duty-
paid or from non-duty-paid tobacco, and of putting up for use or
consumption in any way any scraps, waste, chippings, stems, or
deposits of tobacco resulting from any processing of tobacco;
“manufactured tobacco” means tobacco that has been manufactured or
prepared by any means or in any shape for smoking or for any other
purpose;
“manufacturing warehouse” means any place for the time being licensed
as a manufacturing warehouse under Part 4; and includes a tobacco-
manufacturing warehouse;
“master”, in relation to any ship, means the person (other than any person
not belonging to the ship who has the lawful conduct of it for the time
being in actual charge or command of the ship;
“Minister” means the Minister of Foreign Affairs;
“Normal Tariff” means the rates of duty and the exemptions from duty
specified in the column headed “Normal Tariff” in the Tariff; and
includes any modification or amendment thereof that may hereafter
be made;
“officer” means any person employed in the service of the Customs;

Customs Act 1966

647
“other preferential rates of duty” means the rates of duty and the exemptions from duty specified in the column headed ‘other preferential rates of duty’ in the Tariff; and includes any modification or amendment thereof that may hereafter be made;
“owner” includes –
(a) In respect of any ship or aircraft, any charterer of the ship or aircraft,
and any person acting as agent for the owner or charterer;
(b) In respect of any goods, the importer or other person for the time
being possessed of or beneficially interested in the goods;
“package” includes every means by which goods for carriage may be cased,
covered, enclosed, contained, or packed but does not include a bulk
cargo container or a pellet;
“pallet”, except in the Tariff, means a device on the deck of which a quantity
of goods can be assembled to form a unit load for the purposes of
transportation, handling, or stacking with the aid of mechanical devices;
but does not include a bulk cargo container; and, in relation to a pallet
that is imported laden, does not include any goods laden thereon”;
“pilot”, in relation to any aircraft, means the person for the time being in
charge or command of the aircraft;
“port” means a port of entry appointed as such under section 26 and, where
it is not inconsistent with the context, includes a Customs airport;
“prohibited imports” means goods imported or landed in breach of any
prohibition of importation contained in the Customs Acts;
“proper officer” in relation to any matter, means any officer acting or
employed in that matter by the order or with the concurrence (whether
precedent or subsequent) of the Minister or the Secretary or under any
other lawful authority;
“raw tobacco” means unmanufactured tobacco, or the leaves and stems of
the tobacco plant before they have passed through any process of
manufacture;
“restricted goods” means goods whose importation or exportation is
prohibited by the Customs Acts, whether absolutely or subject to any
exceptions or qualifications;
“seal” means to affix the seal of the Customs;
“Secretary” means the Financial Secretary and includes any officer of
Customs acting for the time being, by direction of the Minister in the
place of the Secretary, whether during any vacancy in the office of
Secretary or otherwise;
“ship” means any kind of vessel used in navigation, not propelled by oars
only;
“shipment” includes loading into an aircraft:
“ships’ stores” includes aircraft’s stores;
“smuggling” means importing, unshipping, landing, conveying, or
otherwise dealing with any goods with intent to defraud the revenue
of Customs;
“Standard Tariff” means the Standard Tariff comprised in Part 1 of the
Customs Tariff; and includes any modification or amendment thereof
that may hereafter be made;
“Tariff” means the Customs Tariff of Niue (comprising the Standard Tariff
set out in Part 1 and the provisions set out in Part 2 as set out in Schedule
2 and includes all notes to the Tariff, or to any Part, section, chapter,
subchapter, heading, subheading, or item thereof, set out in that
Schedule; and also includes any modification or amendment of the Tariff
or of the said notes that may hereafter be made;
648 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“Tariff headings” or “headings”, means the headings of the Standard Tariff printed in bold type, being the headings of the Brussels Nomenclature established by the Convention for the Classification of Goods in Customs Tariffs signed in Brussels on 15 December 1950 and includes any modification or amendment of it that may hereafter be made;
“Tariff items” means the Tariff items of the Standard Tariff identified by 7
digits; and includes the headings to it so identified;
“Tariff subheading”, or “subheading”, means a subheading appearing in
the Standard Tariff and not identified by any number;
“tobacco” includes cigars, cigarettes, and snuff;
“transit building” means a building or any part of a building for the
reception, examination or protection of goods on their loading or
unloading while subject to the control of the Customs;
“uncustomed goods” means any goods on which any duty has become
due and payable and is unpaid;
“vehicle” means any conveyance of any kind whatsoever for use on land;
“warehouse” means a place of security licensed under section 80; and
includes a crown warehouse;
“wharf” means a wharf or other landing place appointed as a wharf under
this Act; and includes a sufferance wharf.
(2) Any reference in this Act to contravention of any provision of this Act,
or of any regulations, licence, requirements, conditions, or directions thereunder,
includes a reference to failure to comply with that provision.

3 Customs Acts defined

(1) In this Act, “Customs Acts” means this Act, the General Agreement on
Tariffs and Trade Act 1948, the Niue Customs Tariff Act 1982, and all enactments
made under any of these Acts.
(2) In its application to the subject-matter of any other of the Customs Acts
this Act shall be read subject to the provisions of that other Act.
(3) Subject to subsection (2), the provisions of this Act, so far as they are
applicable and with the necessary modifications, shall be deemed to be
incorporated in and to form part of every enactment declared by this or any other
Act to be a Customs Act.
(4) In the application of this Act to any Customs Act references to this Act
shall, where necessary, be read as references to that Customs Act.

4 Importers

When in respect of any imported goods there are more importers than one
(in accordance with the definition of the term “importer” in this Act) all the
provisions of this Act with reference to the importer of those goods shall, except
where the context otherwise requires, apply severally and independently to each
of those importers.

5 Customs Department

Customs Act 1966

PART 1
ADMINISTRATION
649
(1) There shall continue to be a Department of State to be known as the
Customs Department.
(2) Subject to the control of the Minister, the Department shall be charged
with the administration of the Customs Acts.
(3) The Department shall have such other functions as may be lawfully
conferred on it.

6 Financial Secretary

There shall be appointed a Financial Secretary who, under the Minister,
shall be the permanent head of the Customs and shall have the chief control of it.

7 Revenue Manager

At every port there shall be appointed an officer to be called the Revenue
Manager who shall, subject to the Minister and the Secretary, have the chief control
and management at that port of all matters relating to the Customs Acts.

8 Officers of Customs

There shall be appointed to the Customs such other officers as are considered
necessary for the efficient administration of the Customs Acts.

9 Delegation of powers

(1) The Minister may, either generally or particularly, delegate to any officer
of Customs all or any of the powers (except this present power of delegation)
exercisable by him under the Customs Acts.
(2) With the written consent of the Minister, the Secretary may similarly
delegate to any officer of Customs all or any of the powers (except this present
power of delegation) exercisable by him under the Customs Acts.
(3) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions imposed
by the Minister or the Secretary, the officer to whom any powers are so delegated
may exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same effect as if they
had been conferred on him directly by this Act and not by delegation.
(4) Every officer of Customs purporting to act pursuant to any delegation
under this section shall, in the absence of proof to the contrary, be presumed to be
acting in accordance with the terms of the delegation.
(5) Any delegation under this section may be made to any specified person
or to the holder or holders for the time being of any specified office or class of
offices.
(6) Every such delegation, whether by the Minister or the Secretary, shall
be revocable at will, and no such delegation shall prevent the exercise of any power
by the Minister or the Secretary.
(7) Any such delegation shall, until revoked, continue in force according
to its tenor, notwithstanding the fact that the Minister or Secretary by whom it
was made had ceased to hold office, and shall continue to have effect as if made
by the successor in office of that Minister or Secretary.

10 Seal of the Customs

The seal of the Customs shall be the Royal Arms having the words “Niue –
H.M. Customs” encircling the arms.
650 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

11 Customs flag

(1) The Customs flag shall be the Niue Ensign with the addition in the fly
of the letters “H.M.C.” in white in bold characters.
(2) The ships and boats employed in the service of the Customs shall be
distinguished by the Customs flag.

12-13 [Repealed by 2004/270]

14 Charges in respect of attendance of officers

(1) Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section
306, Cabinet may make regulations in respect of the attendance of officers of
Customs, whether or not within the working hours of the Customs, at any place
for the purpose of performing or supervising any act required or permitted by the
Customs Acts, and in particular –
(a) Prescribing, except where otherwise provided in any of the Customs
Acts, a rate or rates of charges for such attendance;
(b) Providing for the liability of any person to pay any actual and
reasonable expenses incurred by any officer in respect of the
attendance;
(c) Prescribing the person or persons or class or classes of persons by
whom such charges and expenses shall be paid, or authorising the
Manager to determine the person or persons by whom they shall
be paid.
(2) All charges and expenses payable under this section shall constitute a
debt due to the Crown.
(3) All charges and expenses paid under this section shall be receivable by
the Secretary or the Manager and shall be paid into the Public Account.

15 Districts

(1) For the proper administration of the Customs Acts, the Secretary may
by notice in the Gazette appoint adjacent to any port such district as he thinks fit;
and the Manager at the port shall, subject to the control of the Minister and the
Secretary have the chief control and management in that district of all matters
relating to the Customs Acts.
(2) The Secretary may in like manner alter the boundaries of any such
district.
PART 2
CONTROL OF THE CUSTOMS, GENERAL PROVISIONS AS TO ENTRIES

Control of the Customs

16 Control of the Customs

Goods shall be subject to the control of the Customs, within the meaning of
this Act, as follows –
(a) In the case of all goods imported, from the time of importation until
delivery by the Customs for home consumption, or until exportation
to any country outside Niue, whichever first happens;
(b) In the case of all goods under drawback, from the time of the claim
for drawback until exportation to any country outside Niue;
(c) In the case of all goods for export that are subject to export duty, or
the exportation of which is subject to any condition or restriction
from the time when the goods are brought upon any wharf, or are
waterborne for export, or are brought to any Customs airport or
Customs containerbase for export until their exportation to any
country outside Niue;

Customs Act 1966

651
(d) In the case of all goods on board any ship or aircraft and loaded in any country outside Niue, and in the case of ships’ stores wherever loaded, at all times –
(i) While the ship is within the territorial limits of Niue; or
(ii) While the aircraft is at any place in Niue;
(e) In the case of all goods produced in a manufacturing warehouse,
from the time of their production until delivery by the Customs for
home consumption or until exportation to any country outside Niue,
whichever first happens;
(f) In the case of spirits distilled, rectified, or compounded in Niue
under a spirit maker ’s licence or a rectifier ’s and compounder ’s
licence under the Liquor Act 1975, from the time when they are
removed from the spirit store or distillery warehouse of any distiller,
or from any other warehouse appointed for the lodging of spirits
under that Act, until delivery by the Customs for home consumption
or until exportation to any country outside Niue, whichever first
happens;
(g) In the case of spirits distilled pursuant to a vigneron’s licence under
the Liquor Act 1975, from the time when they are removed from
the vigneron’s storeroom under that Act until they have been used
for fortifying wine produced from fruit grown in Niue or have been
otherwise disposed of under that Act.

17 Delivery for home consumption

(1) For the purposes of this Act, goods shall be deemed to be delivered by
the Customs for home consumption –
(a) As soon as the proper officer gives to the owner of the goods notice
of their unconditional delivery for home consumption; or
(b) On the fulfilment of any conditions included in any notice of the
delivery of the goods for home consumption given by the proper
officer to the owner.
(2) Notice of delivery under this section shall be given in the prescribed
form or manner.

18 No responsibility for safe custody of goods

(1) Neither the Crown, nor the Minister, nor any officer of Customs shall
be responsible to any person for the safe custody of any goods subject to the control
of the Customs, or shall be under any liability in respect of the erroneous delivery
of any goods from such control.
(2) This section shall not apply to goods warehoused in a Crown
warehouse.

General Provisions as to Entries

19 Making of entries

(1) Every entry of goods under this Act shall be made by the delivery of
the entry by the person making it to the Manager or other proper officer.
(2) Any person making any entry shall truly answer all questions asked
by the Manager or other proper officer relating to the goods referred to in the
entry.
(3) Every entry shall be in the prescribed form.
652 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

20 Verification of entries

The Manager may require from any person making entry of any goods
proof by declaration or the production of documents (in addition to any declaration
or documents otherwise required by this Act or by regulations thereunder) of the
correctness of the entry, and may refuse to deliver the goods or to pass the entry
pending such proof.

21 Erroneous entries

(1) Every person who makes any entry (whether for home consumption
or otherwise) that is erroneous or defective in any particular commits an offence
and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or 3 times the amount of
any deficient duty, whichever sum is the greater.
(2) In this section, “deficient duty” means the full duty on the goods which
are comprised or ought to have been comprised in the entry less the amount of
duty (if any) payable if computed under the entry as actually made and as if the
goods had been entered for home consumption.
(3) For the purposes of this section, every declaration, invoice, certificate
or written statement required or authorised by or under this Act to be made or
produced by the person making an entry shall be deemed to form part of that
entry.
(4) For the purposes of this section, every amendment of an entry shall be deemed to form part of that entry, but not so as to relieve any person from any penalty incurred in respect of the entry before its amendment.

22 Passing of entries

(1) An entry shall be passed by the Manager or other proper officer signing
the entry, and on the passing of the entry the goods shall be deemed to be entered.
(2) Any entry so passed shall be warrant for dealing with the goods in
accordance with the entry.

23 Cancellation and amendment of entry

(1) With the permission of the Manager, any entry may, after it has been
made but not later than one day after it has been passed and while the goods still
remain subject to the control of the Customs, be cancelled or amended by the
person making it.
(2) When the Secretary is satisfied that any entry has been made in error
but in good faith, he may permit the entry to be cancelled or amended, by the
person who made it, at any time while the goods remain subject to the control of
the Customs or, subject to such conditions as the Secretary may impose, at any
time after delivery of the goods from such control.
(3) No cancellation or amendment of an entry by the person who made it
shall take away or affect any penalty, forfeiture, or criminal liability theretofore
accrued or incurred in respect of the entry.
(4) The Manager may make a refund of duty under any such cancellation
or amendment of an entry.
(5) The cancellation or amendment of any entry shall be made in the
prescribed manner.

Customs Act 1966

653

24 Amendment of entries by officers

(1) Any officer, for the purpose of correcting any part of any entry, may
amend that entry before it is passed.
(2) No such amendment shall take away or affect any penalty, forfeiture,
or criminal liability theretofore accrued or incurred in respect of the entry.

25 Goods to be dealt with according to entry

(1) All goods in respect of which any entry has been made and passed
shall forthwith be dealt with in accordance with the entry and with the provisions
of this Act in respect of goods so entered.
(2) Every person commits an offence against this Act who is knowingly
concerned in any contravention of this section.
PART 3
IMPORTATION, EXPORTATION, REMOVAL WITHIN NIUE

Ports of Entry, Customs Airports

26 Ports of entry

(1) The Minister may, by notice in the Gazette, appoint as a port of entry for
the purposes of this Act any area specified in the notice, and fix the name of that
port.
(2) A port of entry may be so appointed for any specified limited purposes exclusively, or for all purposes with specified exceptions, or without any such limitation; and if any such limitation is so imposed the port shall be deemed a port of entry in respect of the purposes so authorised only.
(3) The Minister may, by notice in the Gazette, declare that any port shall cease to be a port of entry for the purposes of this Act, or alter the limits or the name of any port, or impose any limitation on the purposes for which any port shall be a port of entry, or remove or alter any such limitation.

27 Boarding stations

(1) The Secretary may by notice in the Gazette
(a) Appoint stations or places at which ships arriving at or departing
from any port shall bring-to for the boarding or landing of officers
of Customs;
(b) Appoint particular parts of any port at which ships laden with any
particular cargo or class of cargo shall moor and discharge such
cargo.
(2) Any such appointment may be in like manner revoked.

28 Wharves

(1) The Secretary may, by notice in the Gazette, appoint proper places within
any port to be wharves for the loading and unloading of goods, and declare the
limits of such wharves and fix the names thereof.
(2) The Secretary may in like manner impose such restrictions with respect
to the use of any such wharf; and so long as any such restrictions exist the wharf
shall be deemed to be a wharf under this Act for such purposes only as are
consistent with those restrictions.
(3) The Secretary may declare that any wharf shall cease to be a wharf for
the purposes of this Act, or may alter the limits or the name of the wharf, or alter
or remove any restriction imposed upon its use.
654 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

29 Sufferance wharves

When the Secretary is satisfied that for any particular purpose there is no
suitable wharf available he may, in writing, appoint any place within a port as a
sufferance, wharf for that purpose, and permit its use for that purpose, subject to
such conditions and restrictions and for such time as he thinks fit.

30 Customs airports

Subject to the concurrence of the Minister of Civil Aviation and to such
conditions as to security and otherwise as that Minister thinks fit, the Minister of
Foreign Affairs may, by notice in the Gazette, appoint any aerodrome to be a
Customs airport, and may in like manner and with the like concurrence revoke
any such appointment.

31 Examination stations at Customs airports

(1) Subject to the concurrence of the Secretary for Civil Aviation, the
Secretary may by notice in the Gazette appoint for the purposes of this Act a place
at any Customs airport to be an examination station for the loading and unloading
of goods and for the embarking and disembarking of passengers.
(2) The Secretary may, with the like concurrence and in like manner –
(a) Alter the limits of any examination station;
(b) Impose such conditions and restrictions as he thinks fit in respect
of the use of any examination station;
(c) Vary or revoke any such conditions or restrictions;
(d) Revoke the appointment of any examination station.
(3) Any examination station in respect of which any restrictions imposed
pursuant to this section apply shall be deemed to be an examination station under
this Act for such purposes only as are consistent with those restrictions.

32 Examining places

The Secretary, by writing under his hand, appoint at any port or Customs
airport places for the examination by the Customs of goods subject to the control
of the Customs and any such appointment may be in like manner revoked.

32A Customs container bases

(1) The Secretary may by notice in the Gazette, appoint places, at any port
or Customs airport, to be Customs containerbases for the reception, examination,
or protection of goods that are subject to the control of the Customs and are carried
or to be carried in bulk cargo containers.
(2) The Secretary may impose such conditions and restrictions in respect
of the use of any Customs containerbase, and vary or revoke any such conditions
or restrictions.
(3) Subject to subsections (4) to (9), the Secretary may by notice in writing
to the controlling authority of any Customs containerbase revoke the appointment
of the containerbase.
(4) (a) Before revoking any such appointment the Secretary shall give to
the controlling authority notice in writing stating that he intends to
do so and that within 14 days after the receipt of the notice the
controlling authority may appeal to the Minister against the
Secretary’s decision.
(b) The notice shall also state the reasons why he intends to revoke the
appointment.

Customs Act 1966

655
(5) (a) Within 14 days after the receipt by the controlling authority of the notice under subsection (4), the controlling authority may appeal to the Minister by giving to the Manager a notice of appeal in writing addressed to the Minister.
(b) The notice of appeal shall state fully the grounds of the appeal.
(6) The Minister shall consider the notice of appeal, and any further
representations made by the controlling authority within the 14 days or within
such further period as he may allow, and, if the controlling authority so requests,
shall afford to the controlling authority an opportunity of being heard by him
within such period or further period as aforesaid.
(7) On any such appeal the Minister may confirm or reverse the Secretary’s
decision, and the Minister ’s decision shall be final.
(8) Where an appointment is revoked under this section, the revocation
shall take effect on such date as is specified in the notice of revocation or, if no
date is so specified, from the time of the receipt by the controlling authority of the
notice of revocation.
(9) Notice of the revocation of any such appointment shall be published
by the Secretary in the Gazette.

33 Duties of controlling authorities

(1) The controlling authority of every wharf or Customs airport or Customs
containerbase shall provide and maintain at the wharf or airport, or containerbase
to the satisfaction of the Minister –
(a) Suitable office accommodation, at such place or places as the
Minister may direct, for the exclusive use of officers of Customs
employed at the wharf or airport or containerbase; and
(b) Such suitable transit buildings as the Minister may declare to be
requisite in respect of the wharf or Customs airport, or Customs
containerbase together with suitable weighing appliances for use
in such transit buildings by officers of Customs.
(2) The controlling authority of every wharf or Customs airport or customs
container base, shall store goods subject to the control of the Customs in such
manner and in such place as the Manager or other proper officer of Customs may
direct.
(3) Every controlling authority who fails to comply with any provision of this section commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units for every month or part of a month during which the default has continued.

34 Storage charges

(1) No charges shall be made by any controlling authority for the reception
or storage in any transit building or on any wharf of any goods, being goods
subject to the control of the Customs, during the period of 24 hours (exclusive of
holidays) from the time of the landing of the goods.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), where any such goods are detained by
any officer of Customs for examination, weighing, analysis, or testing for Customs
purposes, no storage charges shall be payable to any controlling authority in respect
of the storage of the goods in any transit building or on any wharf during any
period of such detention up to 96 hours (exclusive of holidays) from the time of
their landing; but after those goods cease to be so detained there shall be payable
in respect of them by the importer or exporter such storage charges as the
controlling authority determines by bylaws made in that behalf.
656 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

35 Security

(1) Before appointing any place to be a wharf, sufferance wharf, Customs
containerbase or examining place under this Act, or as a condition of the
continuance of any such appointment, the Secretary shall require the controlling
authority or other person having the control or use of that wharf, containerbase or
examining place to give security to the satisfaction of the Secretary for the payment
of duty on all goods that are wrongfully removed by any person from that wharf,
containerbase or examining place.
(2) To the extent of that security the controlling authority or other person
having the control or use of a wharf, sufferance wharf, Customs containerbase or
examining place duly appointed under this Act shall be liable for all duty payable
on goods that the Manager is satisfied have been so wrongfully removed, in the
same manner as if the goods had been imported by the controlling authority or
other person and entered for home consumption, and he shall not be released
from his liability under this section by virtue of any other provisions of the Customs
Acts or because a security previously given has been cancelled or for any other
reason.
(3) All the provisions of this Act as to securities required by the Manager,
so far as they are applicable and with all necessary modifications, shall apply to
securities under this section.

Arrival of Ships and Aircraft

36 Ships to come into port of entry only

(1) The master of any ship shall not, without the written permission of the
Manager, cause or permit his ship to enter any place in Niue other than a port of
entry, unless driven there by stress of weather, want of provisions, or other necessity.
(2) Every master who acts in contravention of this section commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

37 Aircraft to land at Customs airport only

(1) Subject to section 38, the pilot in command of any aircraft shall not,
without the permission of the Secretary given with the concurrence of the Secretary
for Civil Aviation, cause or permit the aircraft to land at any place other than a
Customs airport –
(a) For the first time on any journey from any country outside Niue; or
(b) While it is carrying any goods brought in that aircraft from any
country outside Niue and not yet delivered from the control of the
Customs.
(2) A person importing or concerned in importing any goods in any aircraft
shall not bring the goods into Niue at any place other than a Customs airport.
(3) Every person who acts in contravention of any provision of this section
commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

38 Aircraft landing other than at Customs airport

(1) Section 37 shall not apply in relation to any aircraft flying from any
country outside Niue if the aircraft is required under or by virtue of any enactment
relating to air navigation or is compelled by accident, stress of weather, or other
necessity to land at a place other than a Customs airport.
(2) The pilot in command of any aircraft that is so required or compelled
to land –
(a) Shall, unless the place of landing is an aerodrome, forthwith report to an officer of Customs or to a constable;

Customs Act 1966

657
(b) Shall, if the place of landing is an aerodrome, forthwith report the arrival of the aircraft and the place whence it came to the person for the time being in charge of the aerodrome;
(c) Shall not, without the consent of an officer of Customs, permit any goods carried in the aircraft to be unloaded from it or any of the crew or passengers to depart from its vicinity;
(d) Shall comply with any directions given by an officer of Customs in respect of any goods carried in the aircraft.
(3) No passenger or member of the crew of any aircraft that is so required
or compelled to land shall leave the vicinity of the aircraft without the consent of
an officer of Customs or a constable.
(4) Nothing in this section shall prohibit the departure of crew or passengers
from the vicinity of an aircraft or the removal of goods from it of that departure or
removal is necessary for reasons of health or safety, or for the preservation of life
or property.
(5) The pilot in command of any aircraft to which this section applies shall
not be held to have committed a breach of this section if he proves that –
(a) No officer of Customs or constable was readily accessible; and
(b) He did not permit any goods to be unloaded from the aircraft or
any passengers to depart from its vicinity; and
(c) As soon as was practicable, he resumed and completed his flight.
(6) Every person in charge of an aerodrome to whom a report is made
under subsection (2) (b) shall forthwith report the arrival of the aircraft to an officer
of Customs.
(7) Every person who acts in contravention of this section commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

39 Transshipment of goods

(1) Except as permitted by the Manager, the master of any coastal ship or
the pilot in command of any aircraft (other than an aircraft arriving on a journey
from any country outside Niue), shall not, at any place other than a port of entry
or Customs airport, cause or permit any goods to be transhipped into his ship or
aircraft from –
(a) Any ship, except a coastal ship; or
(b) Any aircraft arriving on a journey from any country outside Niue.
(2) This Part shall apply –
(a) To any goods so transhipped otherwise than at a port of entry or
Customs airport; and
(b) To any ship or aircraft into which such goods are transhipped –
as if the goods had been loaded into that ship or aircraft in a country outside
Niue.
(3) Every master or pilot in command who acts in contravention of subsection (1) commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

40 Interference with cargo

If at any time after any ship or aircraft carrying goods brought from any
country outside Niue arrives within the territorial limits of Niue and, before a
report is made in Niue under section 45 –
(a) Bulk is broken; or
(b) Any alteration is made in the stowage of any goods carried, so as to
facilitate the unloading of any part thereof before due report has
been made; or
658 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(c) Any part of the goods is staved, destroyed or thrown overboard, or any package is opened –
and the matter is not explained to the satisfaction of a Manager, the master of the ship or pilot in command of the aircraft shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

41 Boarding of ships at sea

(1) The master of every ship arriving within the territorial limits of Niue
shall bring his ship to for boarding on being approached by or hailed or signalled
from any vessel in the service of the Customs having hoisted the Customs flag, or
from any other vessel in the service of Her Majesty (whether in respect of the
Government of Niue or otherwise) having hoisted the proper ensign and pendant;
and shall by all reasonable means facilitate the boarding of the ship by the officers
of Customs or by an officer of the vessel so approaching, hailing, or signalling.
(2) If the master fails to comply with this section he commits an offence
and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

42 Boarding of ships at boarding stations

(1) The master of every ship arriving at any port from any country outside
Niue shall bring his ships to for boarding at the boarding station appointed for
that port under this Act, and shall by all reasonable means facilitate the boarding
of the ship by the officers of Customs.
(2) If the master fails to comply with this section he commits an offence
and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

43 Stations of ships

(1) The master of every ship, after his ship has been brought to at the
boarding station and boarded by the officer, and after receiving permission from
the proper officer of Customs, shall come up to the proper place of mooring or
unloading as quickly as practicable without touching at any other place.
(2) After a ship has arrived at the proper place of mooring or unloading it
shall not, except by the authority of the Manager or by direction of the harbour
authority, be removed therefrom before the discharge of the cargo intended to be
discharged at that port.
(3) If any provision of this section is contravened the master shall be guilty
of an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

44 Aircraft brought to examination station

(1) The pilot in command of every aircraft arriving at a Customs airport –
(a) For the first time on any journey from any country outside Niue; or
(b) While it is carrying goods brought in that aircraft from any country
outside Niue and not yet delivered from the control of the Customs –
shall, on landing, forthwith take his aircraft to the examination station at the airport.
(2) The pilot shall not be held to have committed a breach of subsection (1)
if he satisfies the Manager that –
(a) He was prevented, by circumstances over which he had no control,
from so taking his aircraft to the examination station; and
(b) After report had been duly made by him under section 45, all the
goods carried in the aircraft were conveyed to the examining place
at that airport.
(3) After an aircraft has arrived at the examination station it shall not, except
by the authority of the Manager or by direction of the controlling authority of the
Customs airport, be removed therefrom before the disembarkation of passengers
and unloading of cargo intended for that airport has been completed.

Customs Act 1966

659
(4) If any provision of subsection (1) or (3) is contravened the pilot shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

45 Inward report

(1) This section shall apply to –
(a) Every ship, except a coastal ship; and
(b) Every aircraft arriving at a Customs airport –
(i) For the first time on any journey from any country outside Niue;
or
(ii) While it is carrying any goods brought in that aircraft from
any country outside Niue and not yet delivered from the control
of the Customs.
(2) On the arrival at any port or Customs airport of any ship or aircraft to
which this section applies, the master or owner of the ship, or, as the case may be,
the pilot in command or owner of the aircraft, shall within such time or times as
may be prescribed –
(a) Deliver to the Manager or other proper officer an inward report in
such form and manner, containing such particulars verified by
declaration, and with such supporting documents, as may be
prescribed; and
(b) Answer all questions asked by the Manager or other proper officer
relating to the ship or aircraft and its passengers, crew, cargo, stores
and voyage.
(3) If the master or owner or pilot fails to comply with subsection (2) he
commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(4) If the inward report so delivered is false, misleading, or defective in
any particular, or if any document so delivered is not genuine or is false or
misleading, or if the answer to any question is false or misleading, the master or
pilot and the owner shall each be guilty of an offence and shall be severally liable
to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

46 Report of wrecked ships and aircraft

(1) When any ship or any aircraft carrying goods taken on board in any
country outside Niue and not yet delivered from the control of the Customs is lost
or wrecked within the territorial limits of Niue, the master or owner of the ship or,
as the case may require, the pilot in command or owner of the aircraft, shall without
unnecessary delay report the loss or wreck to the Manager at the port nearest to
the place where the ship or aircraft was lost or wrecked, and shall comply, so far
as it is possible for him to do so, with section 45(2) (a) and (b).
(2) If any of the provisions of this section are not complied with, the master
or pilot and the owner shall each be guilty of an offence and shall be severally
liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

47 “Importation” defined

Importation

(1) For all the purposes of this Act, goods shall, except where otherwise expressly provided, be deemed to be imported into Niue if and so soon as in any manner whatever, whether lawfully or unlawfully, they are brought or come within the territorial limits of Niue from any country outside those limits.
(2) Goods whose destination is outside the territorial limits of Niue, and
ships’ stores, shall not be deemed to have been so imported unless, while they are
within those limits, they are removed from the ship or aircraft in which they arrived
there, but if so removed they shall for all the purposes of this Act be deemed to
have been brought within the territorial limits of Niue.
660

48

1.

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Prohibited imports

(1) No person shall import into Niue any of the goods specified in Schedule
(2) Subject to subsection (3), the Cabinet may by regulation prohibit the
importation into Niue of –
(a) Any specified goods;
(b) Goods of any specified class or classes;
(c) All goods except goods of a specified class or specified classes;
(d) All goods whatsoever (without specification of any such goods or
of the class or classes to which they belong).
(3) The Cabinet may exercise the powers conferred on it by subsection (2)
if in its opinion such exercise is necessary –
(a) In the public interest; or
(b) For the protection of the revenue; or
(c) For the efficient administration of the Customs Acts; or
(d) For the prevention of fraud or deception, whether in relation to the
Customs Acts or not; or
(e) For the prevention of any communicable disease; or
(f) In respect of goods whose sale in Niue would be an offence against
the law.
(4) Any prohibition imposed under this section –
(a) May be general; or
(b) May be limited to the importation of goods from any specified place
or by or from any specified person or class of persons; or
(c) May, whether general or limited, be absolute or conditional.
(5) Any such conditional prohibition may allow the importation of goods –
(a) Under the authority of a licence, or a permit (whether granted before
or after the importation of the goods), or a consent to be granted by
the Minister or by any other prescribed person upon or subject to
such terms or conditions (if any), not inconsistent with the
provisions of the prohibition, as may be imposed by the Minister
or other person granting the licence, permit, or consent; or
(b) On or subject to any other prescribed conditions whatsoever.
(6) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(7) Every person commits an offence against this section who –
(a) Imports into Niue or unships or lands in Niue any goods whose
importation is prohibited by this section; or
(b) Commits any breach of, or fails in any respect to comply with, any
term or condition on or subject to which there has been granted,
under any regulation made under this section, any licence, permit,
or consent under the authority of which any goods are imported
into Niue.
(8) Every person commits an offence against this section who –
(a) Is knowingly concerned in any importation, unshipment, landing,
breaching or non-compliance to which any provision of subsection
(7) applies; or
(b) Without lawful justification or excuse, removes from any wharf,
Customs airport, Customs containerbase or examining place any
imported goods whose importation constitutes an offence against
this section; or

Customs Act 1966

661
(c) Is knowingly concerned in or connives at the removal from any wharf, Customs airport, Customs containerbase or examining place of any goods whose importation constitutes an offence against this section.
(9) Where any goods are imported into Niue under the authority of a licence or permit or consent granted under regulations made under this section, and any person has knowingly made any false declaration or statement –
(a) For the purpose of obtaining that licence, permit, or consent; or
(b) As to compliance with any condition on or subject to which the
licence, permit, or consent was granted –
he shall be guilty of an offence against this section.
(10) Every person who commits an offence against this section is liable
to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or 3 times the value of the goods to which
the offence relates, whichever sum is the greater.
(11)Any goods in respect of which any offence against this section is
committed shall be forfeited.
(12) No goods otherwise dutiable shall be exempt from duty because
their importation is unlawful.

49 Importation of brandy, whisky and rum

(1) Except as provided in subsection (3), no brandy imported into Niue
shall be delivered from the control of the Customs unless the Secretary is satisfied
that –
(a) It is wholly the distillate of the fermented juice of fresh grapes; and
(b) It has been matured by storage in wood for a period of not less than
3 years.
(2) Except as provided in subsection (3), no whisky or rum imported into
Niue shall be delivered from the control of the Customs unless the Secretary is
satisfied that it has been matured by storage in wood for a period of not less than –
(a) Three years in the case of whisky; and
(b) Two years in the case of rum.
(3) Any brandy, whisky, or rum that does not conform to the requirements
of this section may be delivered from the control of the Customs, by direction of
the Secretary, if he is satisfied that it is intended for scientific or industrial use or
for such other purposes as he may permit.

50 Goods not to be landed or dealt with without permission

(1) Except as provided by this Act, no goods that are subject to the control
of the Customs, and no goods that would become subject to that control if
unshipped or landed, shall be unshipped or landed from any ship or aircraft to
which this subsection applies, except pursuant to –
(a) An entry made and passed in respect of those goods; or
(b) A written permit granted by the Manager in respect of it:
Provided that if the landing of goods from any ship or aircraft is necessary for
reasons of health or safety, or for the preservation of life or property, and if the
permission of the Manager or other proper officer cannot readily be sought, the
goods may be landed without such permission.
(2) Subsection (1) shall apply to:
(a) Every ship, except a coastal ship; and
(b) Every aircraft arriving at a Customs airport while carrying any
goods brought in that aircraft from any country outside Niue.
662 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) Subsection (1) shall not apply to any pallet that has a value of less than
0.5 penalty units and is imported laden.
(4) Every person who acts in contravention of this section commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units and the goods in
respect of which the offence is committed shall be forfeited.

51 [Repealed 11/31/1968 (NZ)]

52 Method of unshipment

(1) All goods on any ship that are subject to the control of the Customs, or
that would be subject to that control if unshipped or landed, shall, if unshipped,
be either –
(a) Landed at a wharf directly, or after direct conveyance to a wharf by water within the limits of the port; or
(b) Transshipped directly, or after direct conveyance by water within
the limits of the port, to the ship into which they are to be
transshipped for export or removal.
(2) All goods on any aircraft, being goods brought by that aircraft from
any country outside Niue shall, if unshipped, be either –
(a) Landed directly at an examination station or, if the aircraft does not
come to an examination station, conveyed directly from the aircraft
to the examining place at the Customs airport; or
(b) Transshipped directly, or by direct conveyance within a Customs
airport, to the aircraft into which the goods are to be transshipped
for export or removal.
(3) Every person who is knowingly concerned in any dealing with goods
in contravention of this section commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units.

52A Removal of goods

(1) Except as provided by this Act, no goods that are subject to the control
of the Customs shall be removed from any wharf, Customs airport, Customs
containerbase, or examining place except –
(a) With the permission of the proper officer of Customs after entry
has been made and passed in respect of it; or
(b) In pursuance of a written permit granted by the Manager in respect
of it.
(2) Any bulk cargo container (including its contents, if any) may, in
pursuance of a written permit granted by the Manager, be removed by the holder
of the permit –
(a) From a wharf to a Customs containerbase or an examining place
only; or
(b) From an examination station or an examining place at a Customs
airport to a Customs containerbase or an examining place only.
(3) Subsection (1) shall not apply to any pallet that has a value of less than
twenty dollars and is imported laden.
(4) Every person who acts in contravention of any provision of this section
commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units, and
the goods in respect of which the offence is committed shall be forfeited.

Customs Act 1966

663

52B Manager’s permits

(1) Goods unshipped, landed, or removed under a Manager ’s permit shall
be dealt with under the permit and with any directions given by the Manager.
(2) This Act shall apply to such goods in the same manner as if they had
not been unshipped, landed, or removed, and for this purpose they shall be deemed
to have remained upon or in the ship, aircraft, wharf, Customs airport, Customs
containerbase, or examining place from which they were so unshipped, landed,
or removed.
(3) If at any time such goods are dealt with by any person contrary to the
terms of the permit or to the directions of the Collector, they shall be deemed for
all the purposes of this Act to have been unlawfully unshipped, landed, or removed
by that person as if the permit had not been granted.
(4) Any permit issued for the unshipment, landing, or removal of bulk
cargo containers shall be issued to the controlling authority of a Customs
containerbase or an examining place and shall relate to such containers generally.
(5) A permit for the unshipment, landing or removal of pallets may relate
to pallets generally, or to pallets imported in any particular ship or aircraft, or to
any specified class of pallets, or to pallets imported in specified circumstances.
(6) Any permit may be granted subject to such conditions and restrictions
as the Manager thinks fit.
(7) Subject to subsections (8) to (12), if in the case of a permit granted to the
controlling authority of a Customs containerbase or an examining place under
subsection (4) the Manager has reasonable cause to believe that the controlling
authority has committed a breach of this Act or of any regulations thereunder or
of any condition or restriction imposed under this Act or such regulations, he
may, by notice in writing to the controlling authority, revoke the permit, or suspend
it for any period specified in the notice.
(8) Before revoking or suspending any such permit, the Manager shall give
to the controlling authority notice in writing stating that he intends to do so and
that within 14 days after the receipt of the notice the controlling authority may
appeal to the Minister against the Manager ’s decision. The notice shall also state
the reasons why he intends to revoke or suspend the permit.
(9) (a) Within 14 days after the receipt by the controlling authority of the
notice under subsection (8), the controlling authority may appeal
to the Minister by giving to the Manager a notice of appeal in writing
addressed to the Minister.
(b) The notice of appeal shall state fully the grounds of the appeal.
(10) The Minister shall consider the notice of appeal, and any further
representations made by the controlling authority within the said period of 14
days or within such further period as he may allow, and, if the controlling authority
so requests, shall afford to the controlling authority an opportunity of being heard
by him within such period or further period aforesaid.
(11) On any such appeal the Minister may confirm, reverse, or modify the
Manager ’s decision and the Minister ’s decision shall be final.
(12) Where a permit is revoked or suspended under this section, the
revocation or suspension shall take effect on such date as is specified in the notice
of revocation or suspension or, if no date is so specified, from the time of the
receipt by the controlling authority of the notice of revocation or suspension.
664 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

53 Kinds of entry of imported goods

Except as provided in section 54 or 54A all imported goods, when they
have arrived at their port of discharge, or with the consent of the Manager at any
time before their arrival, shall be there entered by the importer –
(a) For home consumption; or
(b) For warehousing; or
(c) For export; or
(d) For removal.

54 Passengers’ effects exempt form entry

(1) Goods being the personal baggage or household or other effects
belonging to and accompanying passengers in any ship or aircraft, and not being
dutiable goods imported for the purpose of sale or exchange or as trade samples,
may, subject to any prescribed conditions, be imported or exported without entry.
(2) The Manager may require entry of any such goods.

54A Certain goods exempt from entry

The following goods may, subject to any prescribed conditions, be imported
or exported without entry –
(a) Such bulk cargo containers, and such wagons, trolleys, or wheeled
pallets specially designed for the handling of bulk cargo containers
as may be prescribed;
(b) Any pallet which has a value of less than twenty dollars and is
imported laden:
Provided that in any case where the Collector is satisfied that the pallet
is imported for sale or re-use in Niue he may require that entry be made;
(c) Any pallet which has a value of less than twenty dollars and is
imported unladen, and any pallet (whether imported laden or
unladen) which has a value of twenty dollars or more, being in
either case a pallet which is imported temporarily and in respect of
which a Manager ’s permit for removal is granted under section
52A;
(d) Such other goods or classes of goods as may be prescribed.

55 When entry to be made

(1) Subject to section 57, entries shall be made of all goods unshipped or to
be unshipped at any port, or removed to any port, within such respective times
after the arrival of the goods at that port as may be prescribed, or within such
further time (if any) as the Manager may see fit to allow, but so that, if the goods
are placed in quarantine, at least 7 days shall be allowed for entry after their release
from quarantine.
(2) If default is made in the entry of any goods pursuant to this section, the
Manager may cause the goods to be removed to a warehouse; and if the goods are
not claimed and entries passed therefor within 3 months after such removal, duty
shall thereupon become due and payable on the goods as if entered for home
consumption, and the goods may be sold by the Manager.
(3) If any goods in respect of which default has been so made are, in the
opinion of the Manager of a perishable nature, they may be sold at any time the
Manager thinks fit, either before or after warehousing.

Customs Act 1966

665

56 Vessels or aircraft imported

(1) Notwithstanding anything in this Act, entries shall be made in respect
of such ships and other vessels, and in respect of such aircraft, being ships, vessels,
and aircraft imported into Niue otherwise than as cargo, as the Minister may
determine by notice in the Gazette.
(2) For the purpose of making entries in respect of any ship or vessel or
aircraft imported into Niue otherwise than as cargo, and for all other purposes of
the Customs Acts, every such ship, vessel, or aircraft shall be deemed to have
been imported as cargo and to have been unshipped as such on its arrival.

57 Licence or permit for restricted goods

Where under any enactment the importation of any goods or of goods of
any class or kind is prohibited except under the authority of a licence or permit,
the Manager or other proper officer may refuse to accept an entry for those goods,
or for any goods of that class or kind, until a licence or permit for their importation
is produced to him.

58 Sight entries

(1) If the importer cannot immediately supply the full particulars for
making an entry, and makes by himself or his agent a declaration to that effect
before the Manager or other proper officer, he may make a sight entry in the
prescribed form.
(2) A sight entry, on being passed by the Manager, shall be warrant for the
landing and examination of the goods by the importer.
(3) The importer of the goods included in a sight entry shall, within 7 days
after the passing of that entry, or within such further time as is allowed by the
Manager, make complete entry of it; and if he makes default in doing so the goods
may be dealt with by the Collector as if no sight entry had been made.
(4) Complete entry of the goods included in any sight entry shall be made
in the same manner as if the sight entry had not been made.

59 Delivery of goods on sight entry

(1) The Manager may deliver goods from the control of the Customs for
home consumption in pursuance of a sight entry, but only on receiving such
security as he thinks sufficient to cover the full amount of duty.
(2) Complete entry of the goods for home consumption shall thereafter be
made by the importer within such time as the Manager appoints; and if the
importer makes default in making such entry he commits an offence and shall be
liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(3) Goods so delivered on a sight entry shall, on such delivery, be deemed
to have been entered for home consumption.

60 Goods for home consumption

Except as provided in section 181 when any imported goods have been
entered for home consumption the importer shall forthwith pay to the Manager
or other proper officer the duties (if any) payable thereon.

61 Importer may be required to furnish samples and illustrations

The importer of any goods shall furnish free of charge, for the use of the
Customs, such samples or such illustrations, drawings, or plans relative to the
goods as may be required by the Manager for purposes of analysis, classification,
or record.
666 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Removal within Niue Exportation

62 Removal of imported goods within Niue

(1) No imported goods subject to the control of the Customs shall be placed
on any ship, boat, lighter, or other conveyance for removal within Niue until entry
for removal has been duly made and passed therefor in the prescribed form and
manner.
(2) When any imported goods have been entered for removal the importer
shall forthwith remove them to another port of entry in accordance with the entry,
without payment of duty in the first instance.
(3) The Manager may require from the importer security for the due
removal of the goods in accordance with the entry, and for the payment of the
duty thereon.
(4) When the goods so removed have arrived at their port of destination,
or with the consent of the Manager at any time before their arrival, they shall be
there entered for home consumption, warehousing, export, or further removal, in
the same manner as if no former entry had been made therefor, and this Act shall
apply accordingly.
(5) When any goods so entered for removal to another port arrive at that
port they shall be forthwith brought to a wharf or an examining place or a Customs
containerbase (as the case may require) appointed at that port for the examination
of goods subject to the control of the Customs.
(6) If any goods are dealt with in contravention of subsection (1) they shall
be forfeited; and any person so dealing with them commits an offence and shall
be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

63 Export subject to control of Customs

(1) (a) No goods subject to the control of the Customs shall be placed on
board any ship, boat, lighter, or other vessel or loaded into any
aircraft or packed into any bulk cargo container in a Customs
containerbase, to be shipped for export until entry has been duly
made and passed therefor in the prescribed form and manner.
(b) Where the Manager is satisfied in respect of any goods that their
exportation is not prohibited by any regulation made under section
70 he may permit such entry to be made within 6 days after the
goods have been so shipped.
(2) When any imported goods have been entered for export the importer
shall forthwith export them to a country outside Niue in accordance with the
entry and with the provisions of this Act relating to the exportation of goods and,
except as provided in section 181, no duty shall be payable thereon.
(3) If any goods are dealt with in contravention of subsection (1), they shall
be forfeited; and any person so dealing with them commits an offence and shall
be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

64 Entry for export of goods not subject to control of Customs

(1) When goods not subject to the control of the Customs are shipped for
export, entry thereof for export shall be made in the prescribed form and manner,
before shipment or within 6 days after the shipment, or within such further time
as may be prescribed.
(2) If entry is not made in accordance with this section, the exporter and
every person knowingly concerned in the exportation or intended exportation of
the goods shall be guilty of an offence against this Act.

Customs Act 1966

667

65 Method of shipment

(1) Goods subject to the control of the Customs for export or removal within
Niue shall be brought to the ship, aircraft, or vehicle in which they are to be exported
or removed by the most direct means reasonably available.
(2) Every person who deals with or is knowingly concerned in dealing
with goods in contravention of this section commits an offence and shall be liable
to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

66 Goods not shipped according to entry

(1) If any goods entered for export or removal within Niue are not shipped
according to the entry, the person making the entry shall immediately give to the
Manager notice of the failure to ship and, as required by the Manager, cancel or
amend the entry.
(2) Every person commits an offence against this Act who fails to comply
with this section.

67 Information and securities in respect of exported goods

(1) When any goods have been entered for export the Manager may require
the person making the entry to produce all documents relating to the goods, and,
if the goods are subject to the control of the Customs, to give security that they
will be landed at the place for which they are entered or otherwise accounted for
to the satisfaction of the Manager.
(2) If required by the Secretary, a certificate in the prescribed form, to be
given by such person as may be prescribed, shall be produced by the exporter in
proof of the due landing, in accordance with the export entry, of any goods which
at the time of shipment were subject to the control of the Customs.
(3) A Manager may refuse to allow any other goods subject to the control
of the Customs to be exported by any person who fails within a reasonable time to
produce any certificate so required of the landing of any such goods previously
exported by him, or to account for such goods to the satisfaction of a Manager.

68 Exported goods not to be relanded

(1) No goods shipped for export shall be unshipped or landed, except in a
country outside Niue, without the permission of the Manager or some other proper
officer of Customs.
(2) If any goods which at the time of shipment were subject to the control
of the Customs are unshipped or landed in breach of this section, they shall be
forfeited.
(3) If any goods are unshipped or landed in contravention of this section,
the master and owner of the ship, or the pilot in command and owner of the
aircraft and every person knowingly concerned in such unshipment or landing,
shall each be guilty of a offence and shall be severally liable to a fine not exceeding
2 penalty units.

69 Time of exportation

For the purposes of this Act the time of exportation of goods shall be deemed
to be the time at which the exporting ship leaves the limits of her last port of call
in Niue or at which the exporting aircraft departs from the last Customs airport at
which it landed immediately before proceeding to a country outside Niue.
668

70

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Prohibited exports

(1) Cabinet may, by regulation, prohibit the exportation of any goods –
(a) Being arms, explosives, or military or naval stores, or being goods
which in his opinion may, if exported, be used as or in the
manufacture of arms, explosives, or military or naval stores or for
any purpose of war; or
(b) Being goods the prohibition of whose exportation is in his opinion
necessary for the preservation of the flora or fauna of Niue; or
(c) Being goods that have not been prepared or manufactured in
accordance with or do not conform to any conditions as to purity,
soundness, or freedom from disease imposed by any laws, rules, or
regulations in force under any Act; or
(d) Being goods which would in his opinion be the source of danger to
life or property at sea or in the air; or
(e) Being goods the prohibition of whose exportation is in his opinion
necessary in the public interest.
(2) The powers conferred by subsection (1) shall extend to authorise the
prohibition of the exportation of – (a) Any specified goods;
(b) Goods of any specified class or classes;
(c) All goods except goods of a specified class or specified classes;
(d) All goods whatsoever (without specification of such goods or of
the class or classes to which they belong).
(3) Any prohibition imposed under this section –
(a) May be general; or
(b) May be limited to the exportation of goods to any specified place
or by or to any specified person or class of persons; or
(c) May, whether general or limited, be absolute or conditional.
(4) Any such conditional prohibition may allow the exportation of goods –
(a) Under the authority of a licence, permit, or consent to be granted
by the Minister or by any other prescribed person on or subject to
such terms or conditions (if any), not inconsistent with the
provisions of the prohibition, as may be imposed by the Minister
or person granting the licence, permit, or consent; or
(b) On or subject to any other prescribed conditions whatsoever.
(5) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(6) Every person commits an offence against this section who –
(a) Exports or ships, with intent to export, or conspires with any other
person (whether that other person is in Niue or not) to export, any
goods from Niue, contrary to the terms of any prohibitions in force
with respect to it; or
(b) Commits any breach of, or fails in any respect to comply with, any
term or condition on or subject to which there has been granted,
under any regulations made under this section, any licence, permit,
or consent; or
(c) Knowingly makes any false declaration or statement for the purpose
of obtaining any such licence, permit, or consent; or
(d) Is knowingly concerned in any exportation, shipment, breach, or
non-compliance to which paragraph (a) or paragraph (b) applies.
(6A) Any person who commits an offence against this section is liable to
a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or 3 times the value of the goods to which the
offence relates, whichever is the greater.

Customs Act 1966

669
(7) All goods shipped on board any ship or aircraft for the purpose of being exported contrary to the terms of any such prohibition in force with respect to it and all goods waterborne for the purpose of being so shipped and exported, shall be forfeited.
(8) No such prohibition shall apply to goods that are already loaded into the exporting ship or aircraft at the time when the prohibition comes into force.
(9) Any prohibition under this section of the exportation of any goods shall, unless otherwise specified, extend and apply to the shipment of such goods for use as ships’ stores.

71 Ships in which goods may be exported

(1) Except by the permission of the Manager, no goods subject to the control
of the Customs shall be exported in any ship of less than 50 tons gross register.
(2) If any such goods are exported or loaded on board any ship for the
purpose of being exported in contravention of this section, the owner and the
master of the ship, and any person knowingly concerned in such exportation or
landing, shall each be guilty of an offence and shall be severally liable to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units and the goods shall be forfeited.

Departure of Ships and Aircraft

72 Clearance of ships and aircraft

(1) Unless he has received from the Manager a certificate of clearance in
the prescribed form –
(a) The master of any ship, except a coastal ship, shall not depart with
his ship from any port; and
(b) The pilot in command of any aircraft shall not depart with his aircraft
from any Customs airport for any country outside Niue.
(2) If any provision of this section is contravened, the master and the owner
of the ship or the pilot in command and the owner of the aircraft, shall each be
guilty of an offence and shall be severally liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty
units.
(3) If the master of any ship or the pilot in command of any aircraft attempts or threatens to commit an offence against this section, the Manager or other proper officer may (in addition to any power of seizure and detention under Part 13 for any offence so committed) seize and detain the ship or aircraft until a certificate of clearance has been obtained, and section 292 shall apply in the same manner as if the ship or aircraft had been seized under Part 13.

73 Report outwards

(1) Before any certificate of clearance is granted to the master of any ship
or the pilot in command of any aircraft, the master or pilot shall –
(a) Deliver to the Manager or other proper officer a report outwards in
such form and manner, containing such particulars verified by
declaration, and with such supporting documents, as may be
prescribed; and
(b) Answer all questions asked by the Manager or other proper officer
relating to the ship or aircraft and its passengers, crew, cargo, stores,
and intended voyage or journey; and
(c) Produce such other documents as may be required by the Manager
or other proper officer relating to the ship or aircraft and her cargo.
(2) If the report so delivered is false, misleading, or defective in any
particular, or if the answer to any such question is false or misleading, or if any
670 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
document so delivered or produced is not genuine is false or misleading, the master or pilot shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

74 Entitlement to clearance

(1) Any ship or aircraft shall be entitled to a certificate of clearance when –
(a) Not less than 24 hours have elapsed after application for the
clearance has been made to the Manager; and
(b) All inward cargo and stores of the ship or aircraft have been duly
accounted for and all the other requirements of the law in regard to
the ship or aircraft and her inward and outward cargo and stores
have been duly complied with.
(2) Nothing in this section shall prevent the Manager from granting the
certificate at any time after application therefor if he is satisfied that subsection (1)
(b) has been complied with.

75 Boarding of outward ships and aircraft

(1) The master of every ship departing from any port shall, if required to
do so by the proper officer, bring the ship to at the boarding station appointed for
the port, and by all reasonable means facilitate boarding by officers of Customs.
(2) The pilot in command of every aircraft departing from a Customs airport
for any country outside Niue shall, if so required by the Manager or other proper
officer, bring his aircraft to the examination station and by all reasonable means
facilitate boarding by officers of Customs.
(3) The master of any ship or pilot in command of any aircraft shall not
depart with his ship or aircraft from any port or Customs airport with any officer
of Customs on board in the discharge of his duty, without the consent of that
officer.
(4) If the master or pilot acts in contravention of this section he commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

76 Production of clearance

(1) The master of every ship and the pilot in command of every aircraft to
whom a certificate of clearance has been granted shall, on demand by an officer of
Customs, produce the certificate for examination by the officer and answer any
questions the officer may put to him concerning the ship or aircraft and its
passengers, crew, cargo, stores, and intended voyage or journey.
(2) If the master or pilot acts in contravention of this section he commits
an offence.

77 Departure to be from port of entry or Customs airport only

(1) Except with the prior permission of the Manager, no ship shall –
(a) Depart for any country outside Niue from any place in Niue other
than a port of entry, save after being driven there by stress of
weather, want of provisions, or other necessity; or
(b) Having cleared from any place in Niue for any country outside
Niue, go to any place in Niue other than a port of entry, unless
driven there by stress of weather, want of provisions, or other
necessity.
(2) Except with the prior permission of the Secretary, given with the
concurrence of the Secretary for Civil Aviation, no aircraft shall –
(a) Depart from any place in Niue, other than a Customs airport, for
any country outside Niue; or

Customs Act 1966

671
(b) Having obtained a certificate of clearance at any Customs airport in Niue, land at any place in Niue other than a Customs airport.
(3) (a) Nothing in subsection (2) (b) shall apply in relation to any aircraft flying to any country outside Niue if the aircraft is required under or by virtue of any enactment relating to air navigation, or is compelled by accident, stress of weather, or other necessity, to land at a place other than a Customs airport.
(b) Where any such aircraft is so required or compelled to land, section
38 (2) to (6) shall apply.
(4) If any provision of this section, or of section 38 (2) to (5) (as applied by
this section), is contravened, the master and the owner of the ship or the pilot in
command and the owner of the aircraft shall be guilty of an offence and shall be
severally liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

Stores for Ships and Aircraft

78 Stores exempt from duty

(1) Subject to any prescribed restrictions, such an allowance of stores as
the Manager thinks adequate for the use of passengers and crew and the service
of every ship or aircraft about to depart (whether directly or otherwise) for any
country outside Niue may be shipped free of duty on entry for export under section
53 or from any warehouse, or under drawback of duty.
(2) Such stores shall be shipped pursuant only to an order of the Manager
on request made in the prescribed form and manner by the master or owner of the
ship or by the pilot in command or owner of the aircraft.
(3) On the issue of any such order in respect of warehoused goods, the
stores therein mentioned shall be forthwith shipped in pursuance of the order in
the same manner as if they had been entered for export, and all the provisions of
this Act as to warehoused goods entered or shipped for export, so far as they are
applicable, shall apply to it accordingly.
(4) On the issue of any such order in respect of goods to be shipped under
drawback, the goods shall be forthwith entered in the prescribed form and manner
for shipment as ships’ stores under drawback, and, save so far as is otherwise
prescribed all the provisions of this Act relating to drawback, so far as they are
applicable, shall apply thereto accordingly as if the goods were for export and as
if the master or owner of the ship or the pilot in command or owner of the aircraft,
as the case may be, were the exporter.
(5) –
(6) Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section
306, regulations may be made under that section –
(a) Determining what classes of goods are, or are not, to be deemed
stores within the meaning of this section;
(b) Extending the provisions of this section, subject to such restrictions
and conditions as are deemed necessary, to whalers and other ships
departing from Niue and returning to it without going to countries
outside Niue.

79 Stores subject to duty

(1) If any ship or aircraft not being entitled to receive stores free of duty
under section 78 leaves any port of entry or Customs airport having on board
dutiable stores shipped under the authority of that section or loaded elsewhere
than in Niue, duty shall be payable on those stores as if imported and entered for
home consumption so far as they are consumed at any place, or in the course of
672 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
any voyage or journey between any 2 places, within the territorial limits of Niue at any time before the ship or aircraft becomes entitled under the said section 78 to receive stores free of duty.
(2) Entries shall be made and passed and duty paid on such stores in the prescribed manner and at the prescribed time.
(3) The owner and master of the ship or the owner and pilot in command
of the aircraft shall be deemed to be the importers of such stores.
(4) Any ship or aircraft to which this section relates shall not be entitled to
a certificate of clearance at any port or Customs airport until duty under this section
has been paid.
PART 4
WAREHOUSES

Licensed Warehouses

80 Licensing of warehouses

(1) Any place of security for the deposit, keeping, and securing of dutiable
goods without payment of duty on it may be licensed under this Act for any one
or more of the following purposes –
(a) As a warehouse for the warehousing of dutiable goods generally;
or
(b) As a warehouse for the warehousing of such class or classes of
dutiable goods as may be specified in the licence; or
(c) As a manufacturing warehouse (including a tobacco manufacturing
warehouse) in which dutiable goods may be warehoused for use in
such manufacture or processing of goods as is permitted by this
Act or by regulations under this Act to be carried on in
manufacturing warehouses.
(2) Any 2 or more places of security may be licensed as one warehouse.
(3) Any such warehouse may be situated in any port or outside the limits
of any port.

81 Application for licence

(1) Every person who desires to obtain a licence for a warehouse shall make
application therefor to the Manager.
(2) The application shall be made by the occupier of the premises to which
it relates.

82 Security for warehouse

(1) Before any licence for a warehouse is granted the applicant therefor
shall, if the Secretary so requires, give such security as the Secretary approves,
and in such sum as he requires, for the payment of all duties which may become
payable by the licensee under this Act in respect of any goods warehoused in that
warehouse.
(2) The Secretary may require such security to be given by any such licensee
in substitution for any security theretofore given by him, and may cancel the last-
mentioned security accordingly.
(3) If any licensee fails or refuses to give any security required from him
under this section, his licence may be cancelled by the Secretary by notice published
in the Gazette.

Customs Act 1966

673

83 Grant of licence

On receipt of an application from the occupier of any warehouse, the
Secretary may grant to the occupier a licence for the warehouse, subject to section
82 and to such conditions as he may direct, or may refuse the application.

84 Harbour Boards and local authorities may hold licences

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Act, any Harbour Board
or any public or local authority having the control of management of any harbour
may receive and hold a licence under this Act in respect of any warehouse in the
occupation of that Board or public or local authority, and shall as the licensee
thereof be subject to the same provisions, obligations, and liabilities as any other
licensee under this Act.

85 Licence fees

(1) There shall be payable to the Crown by the licensee of every warehouse
an annual licence fee.
(2) The annual licence fee shall consist of –
(a) A sum computed on the basis of the cubic contents of the warehouse
or otherwise in accordance with prescribed scales; and
(b) In the case of a warehouse which in the opinion of the Secretary on
account of its distance from the Customhouse or for any other
reason, requires supervision involving unusual expenditure, an
additional sum to be determined by the Secretary, not exceeding in
any case $1,500 a year; and
(c) In the case of any warehouse, if the Secretary determines, an
additional sum, to be fixed by the Secretary sufficient to cover the
reasonable expenses incurred by the supervising officer in travelling
between his office or station and the warehouse.
(3) The measurement of the cubic contents of any warehouse shall be in
accordance with regulations made under this Act.
(4) Every such licence fee shall be due and payable in advance on 5 January
in each year.
(5) On the first grant of a licence a proportionate part of the proper annual
licence fee, for the period elapsing between the time at which the licence takes
effect and the next succeeding 5 January shall be due and payable by the licensee.
(6) On the cancellation, termination, or surrender of any licence, the licensee
shall be entitled to a refund or remission of a proportionate part of the licence fee
for the current year of the licence, calculated from the date of such cancellation,
termination, or surrender to the end of that year.
less than 3 months’ notice in writing to the licensee.

88 Cancellation of licence

Any licence for a warehouse may be cancelled by the Secretary by notice
published in the Gazette
(a) If any licence fee payable in respect of the warehouse is in arrear
and unpaid for 1 month after the due date; or
(b) If the licensee is convicted of any offence against the Customs Acts;
674 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
or
(c) If the warehouse becomes, in the opinion of the Secretary, unfit for
the purpose for which it was licensed; or
(d) If the licensee becomes bankrupt or insolvent; or
(e) If the warehouse ceases to be in the occupation of the licensee.

89 Transfer of licence

A licence for a warehouse may be transferred by the licensee, with the
consent of the Secretary but not otherwise, to any successor of the licensee in the
occupation of the warehouse.

90 Surrender of licence

A licence for a warehouse may be surrendered by the licensee by 1 month’s
notice in writing to the Secretary.

91 Closing of warehouse

On the termination, cancellation or surrender of the licence for any
warehouse, or on any warehouse otherwise ceasing to be licensed under this Act,
the warehouse shall be closed, and all goods therein that are subject to the control
of the Customs shall be removed to some other warehouse by the owner of the
goods, or shall be exported or entered for home consumption, or shall be otherwise
dealt with as the Secretary may permit.

92 Use of manufacturing warehouses

The use of a manufacturing warehouse for the purpose of manufacture
shall be subject to such conditions, restrictions, or exceptions as are prescribed by
regulations under this Act or by the licence for that warehouse or by the directions
of the Secretary.

93 Structural alterations of warehouse

(1) No structural additions to or structural alterations of any warehouse,
and no new means of access or egress into or out of any warehouse, shall be made
without the written permission of a Manager.
(2) If any provision of this section is contravened, the licensee shall be guilty
of an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

Warehousing of Goods

94 Entry for warehousing

When any imported goods have been entered for warehousing the importer
shall forthwith warehouse them in accordance with the entry without payment of
duty in the first instance, except where otherwise provided in this Act.

95 Account of warehoused goods

(1) On the entry of any goods to be warehoused, the proper officer shall
take an account of the goods in such manner and at such time and place as the
Secretary may direct, either generally or in any particular case.
(2) Except where otherwise provided in this Act, the account so taken shall
be that upon which all duties payable on those goods shall be ascertained and
paid.

96 Receipt for warehoused goods

When any goods entered for warehousing have been duly deposited in the
warehouse the licensee shall sign a receipt for them in the prescribed form.

Customs Act 1966

675

97 Removal of goods to warehouse

If any goods entered to be warehoused are not forthwith warehoused
accordingly by the importer, the Manager ay remove them to a warehouse.

98 Packing of warehoused goods

Goods entered for warehousing shall be deposited in the warehouse in the
packages in which they were imported, except goods repacked or skipped on a
wharf with the permission of the Manager.

99 Repacking of warehoused goods

(1) The Manager may, as prescribed by regulations under this Act, permit
the importer to sort, bottle, pack, or repack goods in any warehouse.
(2) In every such case a fresh account of the goods so dealt with shall be
taken by the proper officer, and shall be substituted for the original account.

100 Duties of licensee

(1) The licensee of every warehouse shall –
(a) Stack and arrange the goods in the warehouse so that reasonable
access to and examination of every package may be had at all times;
(b) Provide sufficient lights and just scales and weights for the use of
the officers of Customs;
(c) Provide all labour and materials requisite for the storing, examining,
packing, marking, coopering, weighing, and taking stock of the
warehoused goods whenever the Manager may desire.
(2) Every licensee who fails to comply with this section commits an offence
and shall be liable to a fine of 0.5 penalty units for every day during which the
offence has continued.

101 Access of officers of Customs to warehouse

The Manager and other proper officers shall at all hours of the day and
night have access to every part of any warehouse and power to examine the goods
in it, and may for that purpose break open the warehouse or any premises necessary
to be passed through for obtaining access to it.

102 Restriction on right of warehousing

Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section 306,
regulations may be made under that section –
(a) Prescribing in respect of any class of goods the minimum quantity
that may be entered for warehousing or cleared from a warehouse;
(b) Prohibiting or imposing restrictions or conditions on the
warehousing of dangerous goods, or of goods or classes of goods
in respect of which any such prohibition, restriction, or condition is
deemed necessary for any reason.

103 Sale of goods on which dues in arrear

If the warehouse dues on any warehoused goods are in arrear for 6 months
or more, the goods may be sold by the Manager; but in the case of a licensed
warehouse this power of sale shall not be exercised except at the request of the
licensee.
676 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

104 Goods not to be removed without permission

(1) Except as provided by this Act, no goods that are subject to the control
of the Customs shall be removed from any warehouse except –
(a) With the permission of the proper officer of Customs after entry
has been made and passed in respect of it; or
(b) Under a written permit granted by the Manager in respect thereof.
(2) Every person who acts in contravention of this section commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units or the value of
the goods in respect of which the offence is committed, whichever sum is the
greater.
(3) Any goods removed in contravention of this section shall be forfeited.

105 Temporary removal of warehoused goods

(1) Subject to any regulations made under this Act, the Manager may permit
the taking of warehoused goods out of the warehouse without payment of duty
for any temporary purpose, for such convenient time and in such suitable quantities
as he may approve, if sufficient security is taken for the return of the goods and
payment of duty thereon.
(2) So long as any goods so removed remain subject to the control of the
Customs they shall be deemed to be constructively warehoused in the warehouse
from which they were so removed, and all the provisions of this Act shall continue
to apply thereto accordingly.

106 Liability for duty on missing goods

(1) If any dutiable goods are removed from a warehouse by any person
without the authority of the proper officer of Customs, or if any dutiable goods,
after being warehoused, are not produced by the licensee to the Manager or other
proper officer on demand made at the warehouse and are not accounted for as
having been lawfully delivered from the warehouse, duty shall thereupon become
due and payable on those goods as if entered for home consumption.
(2) The duty shall constitute a debt due to the Crown by the licensee and
the importer, who shall be jointly and severally liable therefore, subject to this Act
relating to refunds and remissions of duty.
(3) In this section, “licensee” includes any person who was the licensee of
the warehouse at any time between the warehousing of the goods and the payment
of the duties thereon, and all such persons shall be jointly and severally liable
accordingly.

Clearance of Warehoused Goods

107 Kinds of entry of warehoused goods

Warehoused goods may be entered by the importer in the prescribed
manner –
(a) For home consumption; or
(b) For export; or
(c) For removal for warehousing elsewhere.

108 Entry for home consumption

When entry for home consumption has been made in respect of any
warehoused goods the person making the entry shall forthwith pay to the Manager
or other proper officer the duties, if any, payable thereon.

Customs Act 1966

677

109 Entry for export

When any warehoused goods have been entered for export the person
making the entry shall forthwith export the goods to a country outside Niue in
accordance with the entry and with the provisions of this Act relating to the
exportation of goods.

110 Entry for removal

(1) When any warehoused goods have been entered for removal for
warehousing at any other warehouse (either at the same or any other port or place)
they shall forthwith be removed in accordance with the entry, subject to such
conditions as may be prescribed, and with such security for their due transmission
and for the payment of the duty thereon as the Manager requires.
(2) On the arrival of the goods at the port or place of destination they shall
be entered and warehoused in accordance with the entry for removal in the same
manner and subject to the same provisions, so far as applicable, as in the case of
the entry and warehousing of goods on the first importation thereof.
(3) Notwithstanding anything in section 62 (5) warehoused goods so
removed may, with the permission of the Manager, be placed directly in a
warehouse on their arrival at the port or place of destination.

111 Constructive warehousing

If, after any goods have been entered for warehousing either on importation
or removal, and before they have been actually warehoused, they are entered for
home consumption, exportation, or removal, they shall be considered as
constructively warehoused and may be delivered for home consumption,
exportation, or removal as if actually warehoused.

112 Rewarehousing

(1) When any goods have remained warehoused for 3 years (whether in
the same or in different warehouses) the owner of them shall thereupon either –
(a) Enter them for home consumption; or
(b) Enter them for export; or
(c) Rewarehouse them.
(2) No goods shall be rewarehoused without the permission of the Manager
or other proper officer.
(3) Rewarehousing shall be effected as follows –
(a) An application for rewarehousing shall be made by the owner to
the Manager;
(b) The goods shall be examined by the Customs at the expense of the
applicant;
(c) Duty shall, subject to this Act as to remission of duty, be paid on
any goods found deficient;
(d) A rewarehousing entry shall be made in the prescribed form for
the goods according to the result of the examination;
(e) On the passing of the entry a fresh account shall be substituted for
the last account, and this shall complete the rewarehousing.
(4) When any goods have been rewarehoused this section shall thereafter
apply to them as if they had been then warehoused for the first time.
(5) If in respect of any goods the owner acts in contravention of this section,
duty shall forthwith become due and payable on those goods as if entered for
home consumption, and they may be sold by the Manager.
678 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

113 Crown warehouses

Crown Warehouses

(1) The Secretary may, by notice in the Gazette, declare any building or other place in the occupation of the Crown and lawfully available for such use to be a Crown warehouse for the purpose of this Act.
(2) The Secretary may in like manner declare that any Crown warehouse
shall no longer continue to be such.

114 Charges in Crown warehouses

Charges shall be made and payable in respect of goods warehoused in any
Crown warehouse under the prescribed scale.

115 Warehousing in Crown warehouses

If any goods warehoused in a Crown warehouse are not lawfully removed
within such period after warehousing as may be prescribed, duty shall become
due and payable thereon as if entered for home consumption, and the goods may
be sold by the Manager.

116 Licensed warehouses

Crown warehouses shall be wholly under the control of the Customs, and
shall be specially available for the examination of goods and the storage of seized
and unclaimed goods; but otherwise all the provisions of this Act relating to
warehouses shall, so far as practicable, apply to Crown warehouses.

Special Provisions as to Manufacturing Warehouses

117-117A [Repealed by 2004/270]

118 Penalties for wrongful use of manufacturing warehouse

If the licensee of any manufacturing warehouse acts in contravention of
any provision of any regulation made in relation thereto, or of any provision of
his licence or of the directions of the Secretary, he commits an offence and shall be
liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

119-135 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 5

Valuation of Goods

136 “Current domestic value” defined

(1) When any duty is imposed on goods according to their value, or where
for any other reason the value of any goods is to be determined for the purposes
of the Tariff, such value shall be taken to be the fair market value of the goods
when sold for cash in the ordinary course of business for home consumption in
the principal markets of the country from which the goods are exported at the
time when they were so exported.
(2) The value so taken is in this Act referred to as the current domestic
value.
(3) Notwithstanding subsection (1), where for the purposes of any entry
the amount of the current domestic value is required to be shown or declared, that amount shall be shown or declared, if it is not a whole number of dollars, at the nearest dollar, and, if it is a number of dollars and 50 cents exactly, at the dollar next below the amount.

Customs Act 1966

679
(4) No deduction of any kind shall be allowed from the current domestic value of such goods because of any special or sample discount, or because of any special arrangement concerning the export of the goods or the exclusive right to their sale within certain territorial limits, or because of any royalty payable on patent rights but not payable when goods are so exported, or on account of any other consideration by which a special reduction in price has been or might be obtained.
(5) If it is proved to the satisfaction of the Manager that any drawback of import duty or excise duty has been paid or allowed on any parts, materials, or ingredients used in making any goods, or that any import duty or excise duty has been actually paid on the goods in the country from which they were exported or would have been payable on them in that country if they had been there entered for home consumption instead of being exported therefrom, the amount of that duty or drawback shall be deducted from the current domestic value of the goods as determined in accordance with the foregoing provisions of this section.
(6) When the current domestic value of any goods when sold for cash for home consumption as aforesaid depends in the ordinary course of business on the quantity sold, such value shall be determined by reference to the quantity actually imported at one and the same time by the same importer from the same seller or supplier, except that if the goods are imported under a bona fide contract of purchase made in the ordinary course of business and including a greater quantity of such goods than that which is actually imported at one and the same time the current domestic value of the goods shall be estimated by reference to the aggregate quantity so included in that contract and imported or to be importer in pursuance thereof within a period not exceeding twelve months.
(7) The determination of the Manager or, in the case of an appeal under section 142, the determination of the Minister, as to the existence and terms of any such contract as is referred to in subsection (6) and as to the quantity by reference to which the current domestic value of any goods is to be estimated in accordance with that subsection, shall be final and conclusive.

137 Production of invoice

(1) On the first entry (other than an entry for removal) of any goods, the
importer or his agent shall produce to the Manager or other proper officer the
invoice (as defined in section 138 for those goods, and make, and deliver to the
Manager or other proper officer, a declaration in the prescribed form verifying
that invoice and setting out the true value of the goods for the purposes of duty
and such other particulars as may be prescribed.
(2) Unless the Secretary otherwise directs in relation to any class or classes
of goods or transactions, the Manager or other proper officer shall retain the invoice
so produced, or a legible copy thereof made by carbon or other duplicating process
by or on behalf of the seller or consignor of the goods.
(3) If any failure to produce the invoice as required by this section is
accounted for to the satisfaction of the Manager or other proper officer, proof of
its contents by a copy of otherwise may be received in lieu of its production.

138 “Invoice” defined

(1) In this Act, “invoice” means –
(a) In the case of goods imported on their sale, the original invoice
prepared and issued by or on behalf of the seller showing –
(i) the true description of the goods; and
(ii) their current domestic value; and
680 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(iii) the actual money price paid or to be paid for them by the purchaser; or
(b) In the case of goods imported otherwise than on their sale, the original invoice prepared and issued by the consignor showing – (i) the true description of the goods; and
(ii) their current domestic value.
(2) Every invoice for imported goods shall be in the prescribed form.

139 Blank invoices

If any person has in his possession, without reasonable excuse, any blank
or partly blank invoice forms, capable of being filled up and used as an invoice in
such manner as to be likely to deceive the officers of the Customs, he commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

140 Valuation of goods by Collector

(1) Subject to this section, the amount of the invoice, after deducting
therefrom all reasonable and lawful deductions in respect of discount, freight,
insurance, and other charges, may be accepted by the Manager as sufficient proof
of the current domestic value of the goods for purposes of duty, and he may value
the goods and assess the duty accordingly.
(2) If the importer satisfies the Manager that the current domestic value of
the goods for purposes of duty is less than the value as shown by the invoice after
making such deductions as aforesaid, the Manager shall value the goods at the
lower sum accordingly, and shall assess the duty on that value.
(3) If the Manager has reason to believe or suspect that the current domestic
value of the goods for purposes of duty is greater than the amount of the invoice,
after making such deductions as aforesaid, he may value the goods at such higher
sum as he thinks proper, and assess the duty accordingly.

141 Valuation presumed to be correct

Every valuation made by the Manager under this Part (whether in
accordance with the invoice or not) shall be taken to be correct, and duty shall be
payable in accordance therewith, unless on appeal to the Minister under section
142 or in proceedings taken under this Act in a court of competent jurisdiction, a
different amount is proved to be the correct value of the goods for the purpose of

ad valorem duty.

142 Appeal to Minister from valuation

(1) From any valuation made by the Manager under this Part (whether in
accordance with the invoice or not) the importer may appeal to the Minister.
(2) Notice of appeal under this section shall be given in writing to the
Manager within 14 days after the assessment of duty, or without such further
time as may be allowed by the Manager and while the goods still remain subject
to the control of the Customs.
(3) On any such appeal the Minister shall, by himself or his lawful delegate,
after giving a reasonable opportunity to the appellant to be heard, determine the
true value of the goods for purposes of duty, and his decision on all questions of
fact shall be final, except in the case of fraud.
(4) The Minister may delegate his power of hearing and determining any
such appeal to any person or persons, whether officers of the Customs or not, but
otherwise all the provisions of this Act as to the delegation of powers by the
Minister shall apply to any delegation under this section.
(5) On any such appeal the burden of proving the true value of the goods
shall be upon the appellant.

Customs Act 1966

681
(6) If any such appeal is unsuccessful, the reasonable costs incurred by the Customs in the appeal, as fixed by the Minister or his delegate under such regulations (if any) as may be made in that behalf, shall be added to the duty and shall be paid by the appellant accordingly.
(7) If no appeal is so made to the Minister, the other provisions of this Act as to the recovery and refund of duty shall apply as if no such right of appeal has existed.

143 Invoices in foreign currency

(1) If the invoice shows the value of the goods in any currency other than
that in force in Niue the value in Niue currency shall be ascertained according to
a fair rate of exchange, to be declared in case of doubt by the Minister.
(2) For the purposes of this Act, the Minister may from time to time, by
notice in the Gazette, determine the relation of Niue currency to the currency of
any other country.
(3) Any such notice may at any time in like manner be amended or revoked.

144 Country of export

(1) Goods exported to Niue from any country but passing through any
other country on their voyage to Niue (whether transshipped in that other country
or not) shall be valued for duty as if they were imported directly from the first-
mentioned country.
(2) The determination of the Manager as to the true country of export in
any such case shall in every court or judicial proceeding be taken to be correct
unless the contrary is proved.

145 Current domestic value of goods imported through intermediate country

(1) In this section, “intermediate country” means the country, not being
the country of origin, from which any goods are imported into Niue.
(2) Notwithstanding section 136 the current domestic value of any goods
imported into Niue from an intermediate country may, in such cases as Cabinet
prescribes by regulation, be assessed at an amount exceeding, by such percentage
as may be prescribed, the current domestic value of those goods in the country
from which they were exported to the intermediate country at the time of their
exportation to that country.

146 Valuation for assessment of duties

(1) If in the opinion of the Minister it is difficult, inequitable, or
impracticable to determine the value of goods for the purposes of duty under
section 136 because –
(a) The goods are not sold for use or consumption in the country of
export; or
(b) They are not so sold in the ordinary course of business or in
quantities similar to those imported into Niue; or
(c) The exporter retains the property in them; or
(d) They are not imported on their sale; or
(e) They are not imported in pursuance of a bona fide contract of
purchase made in the ordinary course of business; or
(f) There is no reliable means of estimating their value owing to the
imposition of a royalty on them; or
682 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(g) They are usually or exclusively sold or disposed of by or to agents, or re sold or imported in or under any other unusual or peculiar manner, conditions, or restrictions, either by way of limitation of purchases from or sales to any person or associations of persons or for any other reason –
the Minister shall determine the current domestic value of the goods in such
manner and at such sum as he thinks just, and shall assess the duty accordingly,
and his assessment shall be final.
(2) The current domestic value of goods as determined under this section
shall not exceed the price at which the goods are, in the country of exportation
and at the time when they were exported, sold in the ordinary course of business
for domestic consumption to the ultimate consumer, if in the opinion of the Minister
such price can be ascertained.
(3) Notwithstanding subsections (1) and (2), in the case of any goods being
the produce or manufacture of a country not forming part of the Commonwealth,
and being goods of a class or kind produced or manufactured in some part of the
Commonwealth, the Minister may, in the exercise of the powers conferred on him
by this section, determine a nominal value of those goods (whether such value is
in his opinion that true current domestic value or not), if in his opinion the
importation of those goods would, but for this section, be likely to affect
prejudicially or injuriously any industry, trade, business, or occupation established
or carried on in Niue or elsewhere in the Commonwealth.
(4) The nominal value determined under subsection (3) shall be such that
the cost of the goods to the importer, including the duty payable thereon, shall not
exceed by more than 20 percent the cost of similar goods, as determined by the
Minister, including the duty on it, imported from and being the produce or
manufacture of some part of the Commonwealth.
(5) The value so determined by the Minister shall be final, and for the
purposes of the assessment of duties it shall be deemed to be the current domestic
value.

147 Crown’s right of compulsory purchase

(1) For the protection of the revenue against the undervaluation of goods
subject to ad valorem duty, any goods of which entry is made may, at any time
while they remain subject to the control of the Customs, be taken by the Crown at
a price equal to their declared current domestic value, with the addition of such
charges for freight, insurance, and other matters incidental to their importation as
the Secretary thinks reasonable, and with the addition of any duties already paid
thereon.
(2) The aforesaid right of taking goods shall be exercised only by the
Secretary or the Minister, and the taking of the goods shall be deemed to have
been effected as soon as a warrant for their taking has been signed by the Secretary
or the Minister.
(3) On the signing of the warrant the goods shall become the property of
the Crown, and shall be sold by the Manager, and the proceeds of such sale shall
be accounted for as Customs revenue.
(4) The price payable by the Crown for the goods so taken shall be paid
out of Customs revenue to the person making the entry.
(5) This section shall not be so construed as to restrict or take away any
other powers possessed by the Customs in respect of the goods or any liability of
the importer or any other person in respect of any offence committed in respect of
the goods.

Customs Act 1966

683

Origin of Imported Goods

148 Determining country of origin

(1) Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section
306, Cabinet may make regulations prescribing –
(a) The classes of goods that shall be deemed for the purposes of the
Customs Acts to be the produce or manufacture of any country;
(b) The conditions to be fulfilled before any goods shall be deemed to
be the produce or manufacture of any particular country.
(2) In respect of fish, whales, or other natural produce of the sea, or goods
produced or manufactured wholly or partly therefrom at sea, anything done by
or on board a ship belonging to any country shall be deemed for the purposes of
this Act to have been done in that country, and any such produce of the sea or
goods so produced or manufactured therefrom at sea, if brought direct to Niue,
shall be deemed to be imported into Niue from that country.
(3) If any question arises as to the country to which any ship belongs for
the purposes of subsection (2) the question shall be determined by the Minister,
whose decision shall be final.

149 Importer to state country of origin

On making entry of any goods the importer or his agent shall state to the
best of his knowledge, information, and belief the country of which the goods are
the produce or manufacturer and shall satisfy the Manager of the truth of such
statement, by declaration or otherwise, in the prescribed form.

150 Entry of goods at preferential rates

(1) Notwithstanding anything in section 119 or section 120 or elsewhere in
the Customs Acts, the duty (if any) payable under the Normal Tariff shall be paid
on all goods imported into Niue or entered therein for home consumption unless
the following provisions of this section are complied with.
(2) Where it is claimed in respect of any goods that they are entitled to be
entered free of duty or at any rate of duty lower than that set forth in the Normal
Tariff in respect of such goods, they shall not be so entered unless, in verification
of such claim, there is produced to the Manager in addition to an invoice of the
goods, a certificate of origin in the prescribed form, signed by the seller or consignor.
(3) No such invoice as is referred to in subsection (2) shall be produced to
the Manager at the time of making entry for those goods, or within such period as
the Manager may allow.
(4) The certificate referred to in subsection (2) shall relate to any goods
other than those to which the certificate mentioned in it refers.
(5) An extension of time under subsection (4) shall be granted on such
conditions as to security for payment of duty, or as to payment of penalties, or
otherwise, as may be prescribed, and on such further conditions (if any), as the
Minister may in any case direct.
(6) In the case of goods sent by post or by airfreight or in such other cases
(if any) as prescribed or with the consent of the Minister in any other case, the
Manager may dispense with any certificate required by this section if evidence,
satisfactory to him, is produced that the goods, if entered free of duty or at any
rate of duty lower than that set forth in the Normal Tariff in respect of such goods,
are entitled to be so entered pursuant to this Act.
(7) Nothing in subsection (1) shall be so construed as to affect the liability
of any goods to duty under a tariff adopted under section 127.
684 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

151 Goods subject to forfeiture in case of false declaration

If the Manager has reason to believe that any goods referred to in any
statement, declaration, invoice, or certificate under section 149 or 150 are not the
produce or manufacture of the country mentioned in the statement, declaration,
invoice, or certificate, he may detain them for examination; and if the statement,
declaration, invoice, or certificate is false the goods shall be forfeited.

Assessment and Recovery of Duty

152 Duty on imported goods a Crown debt

(1) The duty on any imported goods shall, immediately on their
importation, constitute a debt due to the Crown.
(2) Such debt shall be owing by the importer of the goods, and, if there are
several importers (whether at or at any time after the time of importation), then
jointly and severally by all of them.
(3) Subject to any special provisions made by this Act in that behalf, such
debt shall become due and payable as soon as entry of the goods for home
consumption has been made, or the goods have been wrongfully landed or
otherwise wrongfully dealt with without having been entered for home
consumption, or any other offence against this Act has been committed in respect
of them.
(4) Such debt shall be recoverable by action at the suit of the Manager on
behalf of the Crown.
(5) The right to recover duty as a debt due to the Crown shall not be affected
by the fact that the goods have ceased to be subject to the control of the Customs,
or that a bond or other security has been given for the payment of duty, or that no
proper assessment of duty has been made in due course under this Act, or that a
deficient assessment of duty has been made.

153 Duty on goods produced in manufacturing warehouse a Crown debt

(1) The duty on any goods manufactured in a manufacturing warehouse
shall immediately on their manufacture constitute a debt due to the Crown.
(2) Such debt shall be owing by the person who is the licensee of the
warehouse at the time when the goods are manufactured and by every person
who thereafter becomes the licensee of that warehouse at any time before the
duty has been fully paid, and by every person who is or becomes the owner of the
goods at any time before the duty has been fully paid; and all such persons shall
be jointly and severally liable for the duty.
(3) Section 152 (3) to (5) shall extend and apply to the duty referred to in
this section.

154 Duty a charge on goods

(1) The duty on any goods shall constitute a charge on those goods until
fully paid.
(2) If any duty so charged on any goods is due and unpaid, the Manager
may take possession of the goods, and sell them or any part of them in satisfaction
or part satisfaction of the charge.

155 Goods not to be delivered till duty paid

(1) Except as otherwise provided in this Act, no person shall be entitled to
obtain delivery of any goods from the control of the Customs until the sum
demanded by the Manager or other proper officer of Customs by way of duty on
the goods has been paid in full.

Customs Act 1966

685
(2) No action or other proceeding shall be instituted against the Crown or the Minister or any officer of Customs in respect of the detention of any such goods during any period before the payment of the full sum so demanded.

156 Payment of duty by one person not to affect liability of other persons

The liability of any person under this Act for the payment of duty on any
goods shall not be extinguished or affected by the payment of the duty by any
other person who may be liable for it under any other provision, whether or not
the duty so paid has been refunded.

157 Incidence of altered duties

(1) In the case of any alteration in the law relating to the liability of any
goods to duty or the rate of duty to which any goods are liable, such liability or
rate shall, except where otherwise expressly provided, be determined –
(a) In the case of goods warehoused or goods produced in a
manufacturing warehouse (whether before or after such alteration
in the law) by the law in force at the time when the goods are entered
for home consumption;
(b) In the case of all other goods, by the law in force at the time of
importation or by the law in force at the time at which the goods
are thereafter entered for home consumption, whichever is the more
favourable to the importer.
(2) In this section, “alteration in the law” includes any variation which in
any manner takes place at any time or periodically in the liability of goods to duty
or in the rate of duty to which they are liable.

158-159 [Repealed by 2004/270]

160 Assessment of duty in particular cases

(1) When duties are imposed according to a specified quantity, weight,
size, or value, the duties shall be charged proportionately on any greater or smaller
quantity, weight, size or value.
(2) [Repealed 6/28/7970 (NZ)]
(3) Subject to the provisions of the Tariff, for the purposes of assessing
duty on spirits –
(a) The strength of any spirits shall be ascertained in the prescribed
manner; and
(b) If on entry for home consumption it is so ascertained that the
strength of any spirits has increased or diminished by natural
process of change while they were subject to the control of the
Customs, duty shall be payable in accordance with the strength as
so increased or diminished.

161 Alteration of goods

In such cases and under such conditions and restrictions as may be
permitted by the Secretary, imported goods may be so altered as to fall under
another item of the Tariff, and the liability of such goods to duty shall be determined
accordingly and a refund or remission of duty may be made or allowed as the
case may require.
686 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

162 Minimum duty collectable

Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section 306,
regulations made under that section may prescribe the minimum amount of duty
that need be collected on ay goods; and any goods on which the duty if assessed
under this Act would be less than the minimum so prescribed may, if the Manager
thinks fit, be admitted free of duty.

163 Essences and other preparations

(1) Duty shall be charged on all essences, condensations, concentrations,
or preparations of dutiable goods according to the quantity or equivalent of
dutiable goods into which such essences, condensations, concentrations, or
preparations can be converted according to a standard to be prescribed by
regulations made under this Act.
(2) In default of any such regulations, or so far as they do not extend, duty
shall be chargeable as if this section was not in force.

164 Reimportation of goods exported

Goods exported from Niue for such purposes as may be approved by the
Minister, either generally or in any particular case, may on reimportation into
Niue be admitted, subject to such conditions as the Minister may impose either
generally or in any particular case, either free of duty or at such duty as may be
determined by the Minister, not exceeding the duty that would be payable thereon
if imported for the first time.

165 [Repealed 7/137/1967 (NZ)]

166 [Repealed by 2004/270]

167 Power to suspend excise duties on goods supplied to certain organisations

(1) Cabinet may by regulation suspend any excise duty in respect of any
goods or classes of goods manufactured in Niue and –
(a) Supplied solely for the use of such organisations, expeditions, or
other bodies as may be approved by the Minister and as may be
established or temporarily based in Niue consequent on any
agreement or arrangement entered into by or on behalf of the
Government of Niue with the Government of any other country or
with the United Nations; or
(b) Supplied solely for the use of persons temporarily resident in Niue
for the purpose of serving as members of any such approved
organisation, expedition, or other body.
(2) In respect of any goods or class of goods to which this section relates,
the Secretary may impose such conditions as he thinks fit.

168 Samples of goods

Small samples of the bulk of any goods subject to the control of the Customs
may, subject to such conditions as may be prescribed, be delivered free of duty.

169 Duties on wrecked goods

(1) All goods derelict, flotsam or jetsam, or landed, saved, or coming ashore
from any wreck, shall be chargeable with duty as if imported in the ordinary course
and entry thereof shall be forthwith made at the nearest port by the owner or
person entitled thereto or having possession thereof; and all the provisions of this
Act, so far as they are applicable, shall apply accordingly.

Customs Act 1966

687
(2) If default is made in making such entry, duty shall become due and payable in the same manner as if the goods had been entered for home consumption.

170 Liability of owners of ships or aircraft for duty on missing goods

(1) If any cargo or ships’ stores are smuggled into or unlawfully landed in
Niue from any ship or aircraft being within the territorial limits of Niue or
elsewhere, the owner and the master of the ship, or the owner and the pilot in
command of the aircraft, shall (in addition to the liability of any other person) be
jointly and severally liable for the payment of the duty on such cargo or stores, as
if imported by them and entered for home consumption.
(2) The Manager at any port may demand from the owner or master of
any ship, or the owner or pilot in command of any aircraft, at that port payment
of any sum that he believes or suspects to be owing under the foregoing provisions
of this section.
(3) So long as any sum so demanded by the Manager remains unpaid, the
ship or aircraft shall not be entitled to a certificate of clearance.
(4) In all proceedings for the recovery of duty under this section, or for a
refund of duty paid under this section, the sum so demanded by the Manager
shall be presumed to be due and payable until the contrary is proved.

Refunds and Remissions of Duty

171 Recovery of duty paid in error

(1) At any time within one year after the payment of any sum by way of
duty the person by whom payment was so made may institute proceedings against
the Crown for a refund of such duty, or of any part thereof, on the ground that the
duty was not lawfully chargeable, or was charged in excess, and whether the error
alleged is one of fact or of law.
(2) Nothing in this section shall be so construed as to entitle any person to
take proceedings for a refund of duty on any ground on which the determination
of the Manager, or the Secretary, or the Minister is made final by this Act.

172 Secretary may refund duty paid in error

(1) If the Secretary is satisfied that any duty has been paid in error, whether
of law or fact, he may refund it –
(a) At any time within 3 years after it has been paid; or
(b) At any later time, on an application made within such 3 years.
(2) If in any case, after any agreement is made, whether in Niue or
elsewhere, for the sale of goods, the Secretary has authority to make a refund in
respect of such goods, he may, before making the refund, require the production
of evidence to his satisfaction that the importer has remitted to the buyer of the
goods the amount of the refund.

172A Secretary may refund duty on forfeited goods

(1) When any duty or sales tax has been paid on any goods that are
condemned or deemed to be condemned under Part 12, the Secretary may pay to
any person appearing to him to be entitled to it a sum equal to the amount of that
duty or tax –
(a) At any time within 3 years after seizure of the goods; or
(b) At any later time, on an application made within such 3 years.
(2) Such sum shall not exceed the amount that would be available for
payment of duty under section 223 (3).
688 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

173 Remission or refund of duty on damaged and faulty goods

Whenever the Manager is satisfied that imported goods –
(a) Have been damaged or have deteriorated in condition before
importation; or
(b) Are found, either before delivery from the control of the Customs
or within such period after such delivery as may be prescribed, to
be of faulty manufacture; or
(c) Have been damaged or have deteriorated in condition after
importation and while still subject to the control of the Customs,
without the wilful act of the negligence of the importer or of the
licensee of any warehouse in which they have been warehoused,
or of the servants of the importer or licensee –
the importer shall be entitled to a remission or refund of duty on those goods to
such extent and subject to such conditions and exceptions as may be prescribed.

174 Remission of duty on warehoused goods diminished in value

(1) When any imported goods have been warehoused for not less than 2
years and the Secretary is satisfied that, while so warehoused, they have diminished
in value otherwise than by reason of damage or deterioration in condition, he
may in such case and to such extent as may be prescribed allow to the importer a
remission of duty on those goods.
(2) With the approval of the Minister in any case, the Secretary may allow
a remission of duty under this section in respect of any warehoused goods,
notwithstanding that they have been warehoused for less than 2 years.

175 Remission or refund of duty on goods destroyed, pillaged, or lost

(1) If the Manager is satisfied that any goods, at any time after their
importation, and while still subject to the control of the Customs, have been
destroyed, pillaged, or lost without the wilful act or the negligence of the importer
or the licensee of any warehouse in which they have been warehoused or of the
servants of the importer or licensee, the importer shall, subject to any prescribed
exceptions, restrictions, or conditions, be entitled to a remission or refund of the
duty on the goods.
(2) Except where an importer is entitled to exemption from duty under
subsection (1), duty on all goods destroyed, pillaged, or lost after importation and
while still subject to the control of the Customs shall be due and payable by the
importer as if the goods had been entered by him for home consumption on their
importation.
(3) When any goods have diminished in quantity or weight they shall to
the extent of that diminution be deemed to have been lost within the meaning of
this section.
(4) All goods specified in the inward report of any ship or aircraft or in an
invoice produced in relation to any entry shall be presumed to have been actually
imported unless the contrary is proved.

176 Remission or refund of duty on goods produced in a manufacturing warehouse

(1) Sections 173-175 shall extend and apply, with all necessary modifications, to goods manufactured in a manufacturing warehouse, as if the manufacture of those goods were their importation, and as if the licensee of the warehouse or the owner of the goods were the importer of the goods so manufactured.

Customs Act 1966

689
(2) If the Secretary is satisfied that any waste of imported raw tobacco has resulted from any process of manufacture in a tobacco-manufacturing warehouse, he may permit a remission or refund of duty on the tobacco so wasted.

177 Remission of duty on goods not worth the duty

The Secretary may cause any dutiable goods that are subject to the control
of the Customs and are not, in the opinion of the Manager, worth the duty payable
on them to be destroyed or otherwise dealt with as the Secretary directs, and may
remit the duty.

178 Duty on goods from countries not forming part of the Commonwealth

(1) In respect of any goods or of any class or classes of goods being the
produce or manufacture of a country not forming part of the Commonwealth, the
Minister may, on any of the grounds set out in subsection (2), direct that such
goods or any goods of such class or classes be admitted as if they were the produce
or manufacture of some part of the Commonwealth, or, in the alternative, that
they be admitted at a rate of duty intermediate between the rate of duty or
exemption from duty specified in the British Preferential Tariff and the rate
otherwise applicable under the Standard Tariff.
(2) The Minister may exercise the powers conferred by subsection (1) on
any of the following grounds, namely –
(a) On the ground that he is satisfied that goods of a like kind are not
economically produced or manufactured in the Commonwealth;
(b) On the ground that goods of a like kind, being the produce or
manufacture of the Commonwealth, are sold or offered for sale in
Niue at unreasonably high prices and that in the opinion of the
Minister the interests of the public are or will be thereby prejudically
affected;
(c) On the ground that any conditions or restrictions attaching to the
importation into Niue of goods of a like kind, being the produce or
manufacture of the Commonwealth, or attaching to the sale or other
disposition of such goods in Niue, are such that in the opinion of
the Minister the interests of the public are or will be thereby
prejudically affected;
(d) On the ground that goods of a like kind being the produce or
manufacture of the Commonwealth, constitute an unduly large
proportion of the total goods of that kind imported into Niue and
that in the opinion of the Minister the interests of the public are or
will be thereby prejudicially affected.
(3) Any direction given by the Minister under this section may in its
application to any goods be revoked at any time before such goods are entered for
home consumption.
(4) A direction under this section may in the discretion of the Minister be
given in respect of any goods entered for home consumption before the date on
which the direction is given, if an application for such a direction in respect of
those goods has been made at a time not later than the date of entry of the goods
for home consumption.
(5) Where the Minister gives a direction under subsection (4), a refund of
the duty paid or of any portion of it may, subject to such conditions, if any, be
made accordingly.
690 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

179 Duty may be reduced or remitted where prices of Niue goods increased

(1) This section shall apply only in cases where by this Act or by any other
Act that may hereafter be passed goods of any class are made liable to Customs
duty, or to an increase in the amount or the rate of Customs duty, as the case may
be.
(2) The Minister may by order given under his hand and published in the Gazette, remit the duty payable on any such goods, or reduce the amount or the rate of duty on any such goods, if he is satisfied that the prices charged by the producers or manufacturers of similar goods being the produce or manufacture of Niue are in excess of the usual prices that were charged by producers or manufacturers of such goods immediately before the alteration of the law, and that the maintenance of the increased prices would be detrimental to the public interest.
(3) Every order under this section may in like manner be revoked or varied. (4) Nothing in this section shall apply with respect to the duty on any
goods imported into Niue if the Minister is satisfied that the whole of the increase in the prices of similar goods being the produce or manufacture of Niue is due to the increased cost of production, manufacture, or distribution, and has been fixed by the producers or manufacturers under any usual commercial practice followed before the alteration of the law or under a commercial practice adopted since such alteration and approved by the Minister for the purposes of this section.

180 Refund of duty on materials used in manufacture of agricultural implements, machinery, ships and boats

(1) In such cases and on such conditions as may be prescribed, but subject to subsection (2), any person who manufactures in Niue –
(a) Agricultural implements of a kind mentioned in Schedule 4; or
(b) Machinery of such a class that, if imported into Niue it would be
liable to any duty imposed only on goods not produced or
manufactured in the Commonwealth; or
(c) Ships or boats –
shall be entitled to a refund of any duty paid on materials which have been used
by him in such manufacture.
(2) Except in the case of materials used in the manufacture of agricultural
implements of a kind mentioned in Schedule 4, no refund shall be granted under
this section in respect of any materials not being the produce or manufacture of
some part of the Commonwealth, unless the Secretary is satisfied that materials
of the same class, being the produce or manufacture of some part of the
Commonwealth, could not have been obtained on reasonable terms or conditions.
(3) In this section, “materials” means such materials used in the
manufacture of any goods of a kind to which subsection (1) applies, and also such
parts of any implements or machinery to which that subsection applies, and such
parts of ships or boats (including machinery therefor), as cannot, in the opinion of
the Secretary be advantageously manufactured or produced in Niue.

181 Duty on goods temporarily imported

(1) Where the Manager is satisfied that any goods have been temporarily
imported, the duty payable on the goods may be secured by way of deposit of
money or, in such cases or classes of cases as may be approved by the Secretary,
but such other security as is provided for in this Act; and on receipt of such security
the Manager may deliver the goods from the control of the Customs.

Customs Act 1966

691
(2) Subject to subsection (3) and to such conditions (if any) as may be prescribed, the deposit so made shall be returned to the person by whom it was made, or, as the case may require, the security shall be released, if –
(a) The goods, being goods imported to be used temporarily in Niue for industrial or commercial purposes, are exported within 12 months from the date of their landing (in this section referred to as the prescribed period) or within such longer period as the Secretary may determine in any particular case; or
(b) The goods, not being goods to which paragraph (a) applies, are
exported –
(i) Within the prescribed period; or
(ii) Within such longer period as the Secretary may determine in
any case where he is satisfied that the importer is prevented by

force majeure from exporting them within the prescribed period;

or
(c) The Secretary is satisfied that any such goods have been accidentally
destroyed at any time within the period prescribed by or determined
under this subsection.
(3) Where in any case to which subsection (2) applies –
(a) Goods imported to be used temporarily in Niue for industrial or
commercial purposes are exported within the period prescribed by
or determined under this section; or
(b) Any other goods, being goods on which in the opinion of the
Minister duty should be paid, are so exported; or
(c) The Manager is satisfied that any such goods have been accidentally
destroyed at any time within the period prescribed by or determined
under this subsection –
duty shall be payable in respect of the goods on the amount by which their value
for duty, as assessed by the Manager at the time of their exportation or destruction,
is less than their value for duty, as ascertained in accordance with the Customs
Acts, at the time of their importation.
(4) Where the Manager is satisfied that any goods have been shipped for
export, or where any goods have been packed, for export, into a bulk cargo
container in a Customs containerbase and the container has been secured to the
satisfaction of the Manager, he may for the purposes of this section, treat them as
having been exported.
(5) If at the expiry of the period prescribed by or determined under this
section any security has not been dealt with in accordance with subsection (2) –
(a) Any duty so secured by way of deposit of money shall be dealt
with as Customs revenue; and
(b) Any duty otherwise so secured shall be paid to the Manager by the
importer within 14 days after the expiry of that period and on such
payment the security shall be released.

182 Recovery of duty refunded in error

All money refunded by the Customs in error, whether of fact or law, shall
be recoverable by action at the suit of the Manager on behalf of the Crown at any
time within 3 years after the date of its payment, or without limit of time if the
refund has been obtained by fraud.
692 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Drawbacks

183 Drawbacks of duty on goods exported

(1) Drawbacks of duty on goods imported into Niue or produced in any
manufacturing warehouse (whether before or after the commencement of this
Act) may be allowed –
(a) On the export of the goods; or
(b) In respect of such imported or manufactured goods wrought into
or attached to exported goods; or
(c) In respect of such imported or manufactured goods, except fuel or
plant equipment, consumed in the manufacture or production of
exported goods.
(2) Drawbacks under this section shall be allowed in such cases, to such
amount, on such conditions, and with such restrictions as may be prescribed.
(3) Where the Manager is satisfied that any goods have been shipped for
export, or where any goods have been packed, for export, into a bulk cargo
container in a Customs containerbase and the container has been secured to the
satisfaction of the Manager, he may for the purposes of this section treat them as
having been exported.
(4) Where drawback has been allowed on any goods so treated as exported,
the goods shall not, without the permission of the Manager, be unshipped or
relanded or unpacked before export.
(5) If, where drawback has been allowed on any goods so treated as
exported, drawback has been paid in respect of any goods that are unshipped or
relanded or unpacked before export, the amount of drawback allowed in respect
of those goods shall, immediately on their unshipment or relanding, or unpacking
constitute a debt due to the Crown and charged thereon; and such debt shall
immediately be payable by the owner of the goods at the time of their unshipment
or relanding or unpacking.
(6) Such debt shall be recoverable by action at the suit of the Secretary on
behalf of the Crown.
(7) The right to recover drawback as a debt due to the Crown under this
section shall not be affected by the fact that a bond or other security has been
given in respect of the unshipment or relanding or unpacking of the goods before
export.
(8) Every person commits an offence who is knowingly concerned in the
unshipment or relanding or unpacking of any goods in contravention of subsection
(4).

184 Entry for exportation under drawback

(1) Before any goods are shipped or waterborne to be shipped for
exportation under drawback the exporter shall –
(a) Make entry therefor in the prescribed form and manner; and
(b) Produce the goods for examination by the Customs.
(2) The making of any such entry shall be deemed to be the making of a
claim for drawback, and the goods shall forthwith become subject to the control
of the Customs accordingly.
(3) If any goods are shipped or waterborne to be shipped for exportation
before entry has been duly made and passed under this section, the right of
drawback on those goods shall be forfeited unless the Secretary in any particular
case determines otherwise.

Customs Act 1966

693

185 Reimportation of goods exported under drawback

(1) Except in such cases and under and subject to such restrictions and
conditions as may be prescribed, no goods shipped for export under drawback
shall at any time thereafter be reimported into Niue.
(2) If any goods are reimported in contravention of this section they shall
be forfeited and the importer or any person knowingly concerned in any such
reimportation shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding
4 penalty units.

186–193 [Repealed by 2004/270]

194-202 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 7
PART 8
POWERS OF OFFICERS OF CUSTOMS

203 Examination of goods

(1) Any officer may examine, weigh, analyse, and test, or cause to be
examined, weighed, analysed or tested, any goods subject to the control of the
Customs, or any goods that he has reasonable cause to suspect are subject to the
control of the Customs and may for this purpose open or cause to be opened any
packages in which such goods are contained or suspected by him to be contained.
(2) All expenses so incurred by the Customs shall be a debt due to the
Crown by the importer or exporter or the owner of the goods and shall be
recoverable in the same manner as duty under this Act.

204 Examination of goods no longer under control of Customs

(1) After any goods have ceased to be subject to the control of the Customs
the Secretary or any Manager if he has reasonable cause to suspect that any offence
has been committed against the Customs Acts in respect of those goods, may, by
warrant under the seal of the Customs, require any person who has or is supposed
to have possession or control of those goods to produce them for inspection by
the officers of Customs.
(2) Any officer may thereupon exercise in respect of the goods all the
powers conferred by section 203 in respect of goods subject to the control of the
Customs.
(3) If any person fails or refuses to produce any goods in accordance with
such a warrant, or obstructs an officer in the exercise of his powers under this
section, he commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty
units unless he proves that he had not possession or control of the goods or that
he was otherwise unable to comply with the warrant.

205 Boarding of ships and aircraft

(1) While any ship or aircraft is within the territorial limits of Niue, any
officer may board it.
(2) The Manager may station officers in any ship while it is within the
limits of any port, and the master shall provide suitable accommodation below
decks and suitable and sufficient food for those officers and also means of safe
access to and egress from the ship in accordance with the requirements of any
such officer.
694 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) If the master fails to comply with subsection (2) he and the owner of the ship shall each be guilty of an offence and shall be severally liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day during which such default has continued.

206 Searching of ships and aircraft

(1) Any officer may search any ship or aircraft within the territorial limits
of Niue.
(2) In the exercise of this power of search an officer may, by force if need
be, enter every part of the ship or aircraft, and open any package, locker, or other
place, and examine all goods found on the ship or aircraft.

207 Boarding and searching Her Majesty’s ships and aircraft

The power conferred on an officer by this Act of boarding or searching any
ship or aircraft shall extend –
(a) To any ship or aircraft in the service of the Government of Niue;
and
(b) With the consent of the officer commanding or officer in charge, to
any other ship or aircraft in the service of Her Majesty.

208 Firing on ships

The officer commanding or officer in charge of any ship in Her Majesty’s
service (whether in respect of the Government of Niue or otherwise) having hoisted
and carrying the proper ensign and pendant or the Customs flag may, within the
territorial limits of Niue, chase any ship which does not immediately bring-to
when signalled or required to do so, and may, after having fired a gun as a signal,
fire at or into the ship to compel her to bring-to.

209 Securing goods on ships and aircraft

(1) While any ship or aircraft is within the territorial limits of Niue, any
officer of Customs may secure any goods on board that ship or aircraft and subject
to the control of the Customs –
(a) By fastening hatchways or other openings into the hold and by
locking up, sealing, or marking the goods, or otherwise as may be
thought necessary; or
(b) By the removal of the goods to a Crown warehouse or other place
of security.
(2) If any fastening, lock, mark or seal so placed by an officer upon any
goods or upon any hatchway, opening, or place on any ship or aircraft is, except
with the authority of an officer of Customs, opened, altered, broken, or erased by
any person at any time while the ship or aircraft is at any place, or in the course of
any voyage or journey between any 2 places, within the territorial limits of Niue,
the person so acting, and the owner and master of the ship or, the owner and pilot
in command of the aircraft, shall each be guilty of an offence and shall be severally
liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

210 Patrolling seacoast and aerodromes

Any officer and any person acting in his aid may –
(a) Patrol upon and pass freely along and over any part of the seashore
or on the shores or banks of any port, bay, harbour, or other waters,
or over any part of the land immediately adjoining the seashore or
such shores or banks as aforesaid; and
(b) At any time enter and inspect any aerodrome and all buildings and
goods therein.

Customs Act 1966

695

211 Mooring vessels of Customs

The officer in charge of any boat or other vessel employed in the service of
the Customs may haul the boat or vessel upon any part of the seashore or of the
shores or banks of any port, bay, harbour, or other waters, or upon any part of the
land immediately adjoining the seashore or such shores or banks as aforesaid,
and may moor the boat or vessel on it.

212 Questioning persons

(1) Any officer may question any person who is on board any ship, boat,
or aircraft, or who has within 48 hours landed from or got out of any ship, boat or
aircraft, as to whether he has or within the said period of 48 hours has had in his
possession any dutiable, restricted, uncustomed, or forfeited goods.
(2) Any person who, on being so questioned, refuses or fails to answer
any question so put to him, or to answer any such question in writing if so required
by the officer, or answers any such question incorrectly, commits an offence and
shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(3) Any dutiable, restricted, or uncustomed goods found in the possession
of any such person shall be forfeited if, on being so questioned, he has denied or
failed to disclose the possession of it.
(4) It is a defence to a charge under this section of answering any such
question incorrectly to prove that the defendant did not know, and had no reason
to know, that the goods were in his possession.

213 Searching persons

(1) If any officer or constable has reasonable cause to suspect that any
person has unlawfully secreted about his person any dutiable, restricted,
uncustomed, or forfeited goods, he may detain and search the person so suspected.
(2) Any person so detained may, before being searched, demand to be taken
before the Manager.
(3) The Manager may order the person so detained to be searched, or may
discharge him without search.
(4) A woman or girl may be detained as aforesaid but shall not be searched
except by a female searcher appointed by the Manager either generally or for the
particular case.
(5) No person shall be searched under this section unless he has first been
informed of his right to be taken before a Manager.

214 Examining goods carried by persons

If any officer or constable has reasonable cause to suspect that any person
is unlawfully carrying, otherwise than by secreting about his person, any dutiable,
restricted, uncustomed, or forfeited goods, he may detain the person so suspected
and examine any goods carried by him, and may for that purpose open any package
carried by him.

215 Searching vehicles or boats

If any officer or constable has reasonable cause to suspect that any dutiable,
uncustomed, restricted, or forfeited goods are contained in any vehicle or boat, he
may stop it and search it.
696 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

216 Customs warrants

(1) The Secretary may grant a warrant in the form in Schedule 5 and under
the seal of the Customs to any officer.
(2) Any such warrant, unless sooner revoked by the Secretary, shall remain
in force so long as the person to whom it has been so granted remains an officer
whether in the same capacity or not.

217 Entry and search under Customs warrant

(1) Subject to subsection (2) any officer having with him a Customs warrant
granted to him under this Act may at any time in the day or night and on any day
of the week enter into, by force if need be, and search any house, premises, or
place in which he has reasonable cause to suspect that there are any uncustomed
goods, or any goods subject to the control of the Customs, or any goods unlawfully
imported, or any forfeited goods, or any goods in respect of which any offence
has been committed against the Customs Acts, or any books or other documents
relating to any such goods, or any books or other documents containing
information that may lead to the recovery of any penalty or other money under
the Customs Acts and may on any such entry break open and search any boxes,
receptacles, packages, or places in which any such goods, books, or documents
may be or may be supposed to be.
(2) On each occasion on which any officer proposes to use his warrant for
the purposes of this section he shall first obtain the permission of the Manager
who shall not grant permission unless he is satisfied that such reasonable cause as
aforesaid exists.
(3) Any officer so acting under a Customs warrant may take with him and
have the assistance of any constable and such other assistants as he thinks necessary.
(4) Any officer so acting under a Customs warrant shall show his warrant
on demand to the occupier of the house, premises, or place that he so enters or
proposes to enter.
(5) No officer or other person lawfully so entering in pursuance of any
such Customs warrant shall be deemed to be a trespasser by relation by reason of
any act done by him after entry.
(6) When any entry has been so made any officer of Customs may make
copies of or extracts from any books or documents as aforesaid; and in all Courts
and in all proceedings such copies or extracts, if certified by an officer under the
seal of the Customs, shall be received as evidence instead of the originals.
(7) Every person who obstructs an officer or constable or other authorised
person in the exercise of any right of search or other right under this section or a
Customs warrant commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4
penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months, or to both.

218 Requisition to produce documents

(1) Whenever the Secretary has reasonable cause to suspect that goods have
been unlawfully imported, exported, undervalued, entered, or otherwise
unlawfully dealt with by any person contrary to the Customs Acts, or that it is
intended by any person so unlawfully to import, export, undervalue, enter, or
otherwise deal with any goods, or whenever any goods have been seized as
forfeited under the Customs Acts, the Secretary may, by order under his hand and
the seal of the Customs, require that person or any person whom the Secretary
suspects to be or to have been the owner or importer of those goods immediately
to produce and deliver to the Secretary or to any specified officer of Customs all
invoices, bills, accounts, and statements of those goods, and of all goods imported

Customs Act 1966

697
by the same person within 3 years next before the date of the order, and also immediately to produce for the inspection of the Secretary or any specified officer of Customs, and allow him to make copies of or extracts from, all books of account, invoice-books, or other books or records in which any entry or memorandum appears or may be supposed to appear respecting the purchase, importation, exportation, cost, or value of or payment for the said goods and any other goods so imported within the said period of three years.
(2) The Manager may, by order under his hand and the seal of the Customs, require any person (including any officer employed in or in connection with any Government department) to produce for inspection by him or by any specified officer of Customs all or any receipts, records, or other documents relative to any goods with reference to which any question has arisen under the Customs Acts; and to allow the Manager or other officer as aforesaid to make copies of or extracts from any such receipts, records, or documents; and to appear before the Manager or other specified officer as aforesaid, and to answer all questions put to him concerning any such goods, or such receipts, records, or documents as aforesaid. (3) An order under this section may be directed to any corporation or local authority, or to any member, officer, or servant of any such corporation or local
authority.
(4) Every person who fails or refuses to comply with any order made under
this section commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty
units.

219 Documents in foreign language

When any document in a foreign language is presented to any officer for
any purpose connected with the Customs Acts the Manager may demand to be
supplied with an English translation of it, to be made at the expense of the person
producing the document by such person as the Manager may approve, or verified
in such manner as the Manager may require; and until the translation is produced
the Manager or other proper officer may refuse to do any act in relation to the
purposes for which the document was produced.

220 Impounding documents

The Manager may impound or retain any document presented in connection
with any entry or required to be produced under this Act; but the person otherwise
entitled to the document shall instead be entitled to a copy certified as correct by
the Manager under the seal of the Customs, and the copy so certified shall be
received in all courts as evidence instead of the original.

221 Taking samples

Samples of any goods subject to the control of the Customs may, for any
purpose deemed necessary, be taken, used, and disposed of by any officer of
Customs in the prescribed manner.

222 Permitting examination of goods

Subject to any regulations made under this Act, the Manager may permit
any person to measure, count, weigh, gauge, test, or examine any goods subject to
the control of the Customs.
698 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

223 Mode of exercising power of sale

Whenever the Manager is empowered by this Act to sell any goods the
following provisions shall apply, except so far as different provision is made by
this act in any particular case –
(a) The goods shall be sold by auction or tender, after such public notice
as may be prescribed or, if no such notice is prescribed, after
reasonable public notice;
(b) The price shall be paid in cash on the acceptance of the bidding or
tender;
(c) No bidding or tender shall be necessarily accepted, and the goods
may be reoffered until sold at a price satisfactory to the Manager;
(d) The Manager or any officer of Customs authorised by him may act
as an auctioneer in the sale of the goods without being licensed in
that behalf;
(e) The proceeds of the sale shall be applied in the following manner
and order of priority –
(i) In the payment of the expenses of the sale;
(ii) In payment of the duty, as if the goods had been entered for
home consumption;
(iii) In payment of warehouse and other charges;
(iv) In payment of any freight due on the goods, if written notice
claiming such freight has been given to the Manager;
(f) The residue of the said proceeds shall be paid to the person
appearing to the Manager to be entitled to it.

224 Duty payable on goods sold by Manager

(1) When any dutiable goods are sold by the Manager under the authority
of this Act, duty shall be payable thereon by the purchaser in the same manner as
if they had been entered by him for home consumption, and the duty so paid
shall be deemed to be part of the proceeds of the sale.
(2) When the duty on any such goods is ad valorem the Manager may, and
subject to any regulations made under this Act, accept as their value, for the purpose
of assessing the duty, the price at which they are so sold, or any less sum, instead
of their current domestic value as otherwise determined under this Act.

225 Sale of forfeited goods

Sections 223 and 224 so far as they are applicable, shall apply to the sale of
forfeited goods or other forfeited articles.

226 Payments by Manager

Subject to any regulations made under any of the Customs Acts, a Manager
may pay out of any revenue in his hands and received under the Customs Acts –
(a) All lawful refunds of duty, export duty, excise duty, or licence fees
under those Acts;
(b) All lawful drawbacks of Customs duty or excise duty under those
Acts;
(c) The amount of any deposits returnable under those Acts;
(d) The costs of any legal proceedings under those Acts;
(e) All expenses lawfully incurred in the administration of those Acts;
(f) All rewards payable to officers of Customs or other persons under
those Acts;
(g) All money declared by this Act to be payable out of Customs
revenue.

Customs Act 1966

699

227 Expenses of removal and storage of goods by officers of Customs

(1) All expenses lawfully incurred by the Customs under this Act in the
removal or storage of goods subject to the control of the Customs shall constitute
a debt due to the Crown by the importer or exporter of the goods, as the case may
be, and shall be a charge on the goods and recoverable in the same manner as
duty under this Act.
(2) In the case of storage of goods in a Crown warehouse, the expenses
shall include storage charges at the prescribed rate.

228 Reasonable and probable cause

No person shall be liable for any arrest, seizure, detention, or sale under
the Customs Act unless it is proved that there was no reasonable or probable
cause for it.

228A Protection of persons acting under authority of Act

Neither the Crown nor any officer or constable shall be liable for the loss of
or damage to any goods occasioned by anything done or omitted to be done or
purporting to have been done by an officer or a constable in the exercise of any
power conferred on him by this Act or any regulations made under this Act, unless
he has not acted in good faith or has acted without reasonable care.
PART 9
SECURITIES

229 Securities for payment of duty and compliance with Act

(1) A Manager shall have the right to require and take securities for
payment of duty and generally for compliance with this Act and for the protection
of the revenue of Customs, and pending the giving of the required security he
may refuse to pass any entry or to do any other act in the execution of his office in
relation to any matter in respect of which the security is required.
(2) Any security under this Act may, as required by the Manager, be by
bond (with or without sureties) or guarantee to Her Majesty the Queen, or by a
deposit of cash, or by all or any of those methods, to the satisfaction of the Manager.
(3) Any such security may be given in relation to any particular transaction,
or generally with respect to any class of transactions or to all transactions, and for
such period and amount as the Manager thinks fit, and under such conditions as
to forfeiture, penalty or otherwise as the Minister may direct.
(4) Any bond or other security entered into or given under this Act by a
person under the age of 20 years (otherwise than as a surety or guarantor) shall
have the same force, effect, and validity as if that person had been of full age.
(5) Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section
306, regulations made under that section may prescribe forms of bonds, guarantees,
and other securities; and any security may be either in the prescribed form or to
the like effect, or in such other form as the Secretary in any particular case approves.

230 New securities may be required

If the Manager is dissatisfied with the sufficiency of any security, he may
require a new security in its place, or in addition; and if the new security is not
given he may refuse to pass any entry or to do any other act in the execution of his
office in relation to any matter in respect of which the new security is required.
700 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

231 Who may act as agent

PART 10
AGENTS AND CARRIERS

Customs Agents

(1) No person shall act as agent for any other person in the report, entry, or clearance of ships, aircraft, or goods or otherwise for the purposes of the Customs Acts in relation to ships, aircraft, or goods, unless the person so acting is either – (a) A servant or clerk in the exclusive employment of his principal; or
(b) A Customs agent licensed under this Act; or
(c) A servant or clerk in the exclusive employment of a licensed
Customs agent, and approved as such by the Manager under
regulations made under this Act.
(2) If the Secretary is satisfied on reasonable grounds that any servant or
clerk is, whether by reason of bad character, misbehaviour, or incompetence, not a
fit person to act as agent for his principal for any of the purposes of the Customs
Acts, the Secretary may refuse to permit that servant or clerk so to act.
(3) Any person who acts as an agent in contravention of this section, or
who acts as an agent for any other person in any matter relating to the Customs
Acts without being authorised by that person so to act, commits an offence.

232 Licensing of Customs agents

Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section 306
Cabinet may make regulations –
(a) Providing for the granting of Customs agents’ licences or of different
classes of such licences;
(b) Prescribing the minimum qualifications required by applicants for
such licences or, where applicants or licensees are bodies corporate,
by their servants or clerks in respect of whom approval is sought
under the regulations;
(c) Providing for the revocation of any such licences or class of licences;
(d) Prescribing conditions, whether as to security or otherwise, of the
grant or continuance of such licences or of any such class of licences;
(e) Prescribing any annual or other fees to be payable in respect of any
such licences or class of licences.

233 Written authority of agents

Any officer may require any person acting as or holding himself out as the
agent of any other person in any matter relating to the Customs Acts to produce a
written authority from his principal, and if such an authority is not produced he
may refuse to recognise the agency.

234 Liability of principal for acts of agent

(1) Every declaration made or other act done by an agent in the course of
his agency in relation to the report, entry, or clearance of ships, aircraft, or goods,
or otherwise in relation to the Customs Acts, shall be deemed to have been made
or done by his principal also, and the principal shall be liable accordingly to all
penalties imposed by the Customs Acts.
(2) For the purposes of this section the knowledge and intent of the agent
shall be imputed to the principal in addition to his own.
(3) This section shall apply whether the appointment of the agent was made
under this Act or not.
(4) For the purposes of this section the agent of an agent shall be deemed
to be also the agent of the principal.

Customs Act 1966

701

235 Liability of agents

When any person acts or assumes to act as the agent of any other person in
relation to the entry of goods, or in relation to any other purposes or provisions of
the Customs Acts, he shall be liable to the same penalties as if he were the principal
for whom he so acts or assumes to act.

Customs Carriers

236 Conveyance of goods subject to the control of the Customs

(1) No person except a licensed Customs carrier shall convey any goods
subject to the control of the Customs.
(2) Nothing in this section shall apply to –
(a) The conveyance of goods in any ship that is not a coastal ship, or in
any aircraft that is in the course of any journey to or from any
country outside Niue; or
(b) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(c) The carriage of goods by the servants of any Harbour Board or local
or public authority having the control of any wharf or Customs
airport.
(3) Every person who conveys or is concerned in conveying any goods
subject to the control of the Customs contrary to this section commits an offence.

237 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 11
OFFENCES

Offences in Relation to Officers

238 Influencing or resisting officer

Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction on indictment
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years who –
(a) By threats or demands, attempts to influence or does influence any
officer of Customs in the discharge of his duty; or
(b) Assaults, or by force resists, obstructs, intimidates, or endeavours
to intimidate any officer of Customs or any person acting in his aid
in the execution of his duties.

239 Obstructing officers of Customs

Every person commits an offence who, otherwise than by force, wilfully
obstructs any officer of Customs in the exercise or performance of any power or
duty conferred or imposed on him by the Customs Acts.

240 Abusive or threatening language

Every person commits an offence who uses abusive, insulting, obscene, or
threatening language to an officer of Customs while in the execution of, or in
relation to, his duties under the Customs Acts.

241 Personation of officer of Customs

Every person who, not being an officer of Customs, by words, conduct, or
demeanour pretends that he is an officer, or puts on or assumes the uniform, name,
designation, or description of an officer, commits an offence and shall be liable to
a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
702 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

242 Smuggling

Other Offences

If any person smuggles any goods he commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units or 3 times the value of those goods, whichever sum is the greater, and the goods shall be forfeited.

243 Defrauding the revenue of Customs

If any person contravenes this Act, or does any other act, with intent to
defraud the revenue of Customs –
(a) By evading or enabling any other person to evade payment of duty
or full duty on any goods; or
(b) By obtaining or enabling any other person to obtain any money by
way of drawback or refund of duty on any goods; or
(c) In any other manner whatsoever in relation to any goods –
or conspires with any other person (whether that other person is in Niue or not)
so to defraud the revenue of Customs in relation to any goods, he commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units or 3 times the
value of those goods, whichever sum is the greater, and the goods shall be forfeited.

244 Erroneous drawbacks or refunds

If any person obtains any drawback, refund, or remission of duty by means
of any erroneous or defective declaration or written statement, or by producing to
any officer of Customs any declaration or other document of any kind whatsoever
that is not genuine or that is in any respect erroneous or defective, he commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or 3 times the
amount of that drawback, refund, or remission, whichever sum is the greater.

245 Erroneous declarations

Every person who makes any declaration under this Act which is erroneous
in any particular commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2
penalty units.

246 Wilfully false declarations

Every person who knowingly makes any declaration under this Act which
is erroneous in any particular commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units.

247 Production of false documents

Every person who produces or delivers to an officer in the execution of his
office any document as genuine that is not genuine, or any document as true that
is in any respect erroneous, commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 4 penalty units.

248 Interference with goods

(1) So long as any imported goods or goods for export remain subject to
the control of the Customs it shall not be lawful for any person, except with the
permission of the proper officer of Customs, to make any alteration either in the
condition of those goods or in the packages containing them, or to unpack, or
repack the goods or to remove them from any place in which an officer of Customs
has directed that they shall be stored.
(2) Every person who acts in contravention of this section commits an
offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

Customs Act 1966

703

248A Unauthorised entry into passenger processing areas

Every person who, without the permission of the proper officer of Customs,
enters on or remains in any area set aside for the examination, for the purposes of
this Act, or the personal baggage of passengers disembarking from or embarking
on any ship or aircraft at any time when such area is being used for such
examination, commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty
units.

249 Ship or aircraft used for smuggling

If the master or owner of any ship or the pilot in command or owner of any
aircraft suffers his ship or aircraft to be used for the purpose of smuggling goods
or for the unlawful importation, exportation, or conveyance of goods, he shall be
guilty of an offence and shall be liable to the same penalty as if he had himself
smuggled or unlawfully imported, exported, or conveyed the same goods.

250 Ships and aircraft adapted for smuggling

If any ship or aircraft comes or is found within the territorial limits of Niue
having –
(a) False bulkheads, bows, sides, or bottoms adapted for the purpose of concealing goods; or
(b) Any secret or disguised place adapted for the purpose of concealing
goods; or
(c) Any hole, pipe, or device adapted for the purpose of smuggling or
unlawfully importing or exporting goods –
the master and the owner in the case of a ship, or the owner in the case of an
aircraft, shall be guilty of an offence and shall be severally liable to a fine not
exceeding 10 penalty units.

251 Counterfeit seals or marks

(1) Every person commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 4 penalty units who, without reasonable excuse, has in his possession,
or makes, or uses any counterfeit seal, stamp, or mark in imitation of or colourably
resembling any seal, stamp, or mark used by the Customs for the purposes of the
Customs Acts.
(2) Every person convicted of an offence against this section shall, in
addition to any penalty imposed pursuant to this Act, forfeit to Her Majesty, by
virtue of such conviction, all articles in respect of which the offence was committed
and in his possession.

252 Failure to comply with conditions of entry

(1) When under this Act or of the Tariff any goods are, if entered for a
particular purpose or under any condition prescribed by the Minister, exempt
from duty or liable to a lower rate of duty than if entered otherwise than for that
purpose or under that condition, and any goods have been entered under that
provision, every person commits an offence who knowingly –
(a) Uses those goods for any purpose other than that for which they
have been so entered; or
(b) Fails to comply with any condition prescribed by the Minister in
respect of the goods so entered.
(2) If any person commits an offence under this section he shall be liable to
a fine not exceeding 3 times the amount of the duty or additional duty that would
have been payable if the goods had been entered otherwise than under the
704 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
provision under which they were entered, or 4 penalty units whichever sum is the greater, and the goods shall be forfeited.
(3) The Secretary may accept from the owner of any goods so entered for a particular purpose or under any condition prescribed by the Minister the amount of duty or additional duty that would have been payable on them if they had been entered otherwise than for that purpose or under that condition, and thereafter this section shall cease to apply in respect of those goods.

253 Possession or custody of uncustomed goods or prohibited imports

Every person who has in his possession or custody any uncustomed goods
or any prohibited imports commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 4 penalty units unless he proves –
(a) That he obtained possession or custody of them without knowledge
that they were uncustomed goods or prohibited imports; or
(b) That he obtained possession or custody of them with some other
lawful justification.

254 Possession of concealed goods

Every person found in possession of any dutiable or restricted goods
concealed in any manner on any ship, boat, or aircraft shall be guilty of an offence
and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.

255 Failure to answer questions truly

Every person commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding
2 penalty units who, when required under this Act to answer any question put to
him, fails or refuses to answer it, or does not truly answer it.

256 Liability of officers of body corporate

If a body corporate commits an offence against this Act, every director,
manager, secretary, or other similar officer of the body corporate, and every person
purporting to act in any such capacity, shall also be guilty of that offence if the act
or omission constituting the offence occurred with his knowledge and consent.

257 Attempts

Any attempt to commit an offence against this Act shall be an offence
punishable in like manner and constituting the like cause of forfeiture as if the
offence so attempted had been actually committed.

General Provisions as to Offences

258 Offences punishable on summary conviction

Except where this Act otherwise provides, every offence against this Act,
or against any regulations made under this Act, shall be punishable on summary
conviction.

259 Information to be laid by Manager

Every information for an offence against this Act shall be laid by a Manager.

260 Procedure

Any information for an offence against this Act may be laid at any time
within 3 years after the date of the offence.

Customs Act 1966

705

261 Value of goods for purpose of fine

When the amount of any fine under this Act is to be determined by reference
to the value of any goods, their value shall be estimated according to the price for
which goods of the like kind and of the best quality, on which the duties (if any)
have been paid, are salable in Niue at the time of the offence.

262 General penalty

Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no other
penalty is provided shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

263 Imprisonment for second offence

Any person who is convicted of an offence against this Act that is punishable
by a fine only, and who has within 2 years before the conviction been convicted of
the like offence or of any other offence against this Act, may, if the convicting
court thinks fit, be sentenced to imprisonment for a period not exceeding 3 months,
instead of or in addition to being sentenced to pay a fine.

264 Court may order payment of money in respect of duty

(1) In any proceedings for an offence under section 217 or section 218, if
the court is of the opinion that the offence has been committed for the purpose of
enabling the destruction or concealment of any evidence that would support a
claim for duty or other money due to the Crown under the Customs Acts, it may,
in addition to any other penalty, order the offender to pay to the Crown such
further sum in respect of that claim as it thinks fit.
(2) Any order for payment under this section may be enforced in the same
manner as a fine.
(3) The recovery of any amount under this section in respect of a claim
shall not be deemed to extinguish the claim but shall be taken into account in
determining the amount (if any) to be awarded in any subsequent proceedings
that may be taken in respect of that claim.

265 Penalties independent of forfeitures

All penalties under this Act shall be in addition to and independent of any
forfeiture, and all forfeitures under this Act shall, except where otherwise provided,
be independent of any proceedings in respect of an offence.

266 Power of Manager to deal with petty offences

(1) This section applies to any offence against this Act that is committed in
relation to any goods –
(a) Whose value does not exceed $100; and
(b) On which any duty payable under the Tariff and this Act does not
exceed $20.
(2) If in any case to which this section applies any person admits in writing
that he has committed the offence, and requests that the offence be dealt with
summarily by the Manager, the Manager may at any time before an information
has been laid in respect of the offence, accept from that person such sum, not
exceeding 0.5 penalty units, as the Manager thinks just in the circumstances of the
case, in full satisfaction of any fine to which that person would otherwise be liable
under this Act.
(3) If the Manager accepts any sum under this section the offender shall
not be liable to be prosecuted for the offence in respect of which the payment was
made.
706 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

267 Arrest of offenders

Any officer of Customs or constable who has reasonable cause to suspect
that any person has committed any offence against this Act with intent to defraud
the revenue of Customs may, within 7 days after the supposed date of the offence,
arrest that person without warrant.

Rewards

268 Rewards for seizures and convictions

(1) The Minister may order to be paid or distributed out of the revenue of
Customs, to or among any officers or other persons by or through whom any
seizure is made or fine recovered under the Customs Act, such rewards as the
Minister thinks fit.
(2) Where any such seizure or fine results from an attempt to defraud the
revenue of Customs, such rewards shall not exceed in the aggregate half the value
as determined by the Minister of the goods seized or, as the case may be, half the
amount of the fine.

269 Application of this Part

PART 12
FORFEITURES
This Part shall apply to all forfeitures accruing either under this Act or under any other of the Customs Acts.

270 Goods forfeited

Forfeiture

In addition to all other goods elsewhere declared by the Customs Acts to be forfeited, the following goods shall be forfeited to the Crown –
(a) All dutiable or restricted goods found on any ship, boat, or aircraft or bulk cargo container being unlawfully in any place;
(b) All dutiable or restricted goods found on any ship or aircraft or bulk cargo container after arrival in any port from any country outside Niue, not being goods specified or referred to in the inward report, and not being baggage belonging to the crew or passengers, and not being accounted for to the satisfaction of the Manager;
(c) All dutiable or restricted goods found concealed in any manner on
a ship, boat or aircraft or bulk cargo container;
(d) Any package having in it goods not enumerated in the entry;
(e) All dutiable or restricted goods found so packed as to be likely to
deceive the officers of Customs;
(f) All uncustomed goods which are found in any place.

271 Forfeiture of packages

The forfeiture of any goods shall extend to the forfeiture of the case, covering,
or other enclosure, not being a bulk cargo container or a pallet, in which the goods
are contained at the time of seizure.

272 Boats and vehicles forfeited

Every boat, vehicle, or animal used in smuggling goods, or in unlawfully
conveying goods with intent to defraud the revenue of Customs, or in the
importation or conveyance of prohibited imports or forfeited goods, shall be
forfeited.

Customs Act 1966

707

273 Equipment of forfeited boats, vehicles and animals

When any boat, vehicle, or animal has become liable to forfeiture under
the Customs Acts, whether by virtue of section 272 or otherwise, all equipment
thereof shall also be liable to forfeiture.

274 Forfeiture to relate back

When it is provided by this Act or any other of the Customs Acts that any
goods are forfeited, and the goods are seized under this Act or with the Act under
which the forfeiture has accrued, the forfeiture shall for all purposes relate back to
the date of the act or event from which the forfeiture accrued.

275 Seizure of forfeited goods

Seizure

(1) Any officer or constable may seize any forfeited goods or any goods which he has reasonable and probable cause for suspecting to be forfeited.
(2) In any such case such force may be used as is reasonably necessary for effecting the seizure and securing the goods.
(3) All goods so seized shall be taken to a Crown warehouse or to such
other place of security as the Manager or other proper officer directs.
(4) No goods shall be so seized at any time except within 2 years after the
cause of forfeiture has arisen.

276 Where goods may be seized

Goods may be seized as forfeited wherever found within the territorial
limits of Niue.

277 Rescue of seized goods

Every person who, without the permission of the Manager or other proper
officer of Customs, whether pretending to be the owner or not, either secretly or
openly, and whether with or without force or violence, takes or carries away or
otherwise converts to his own use any goods that have been seized as forfeited, at
any time before they have been declared by competent authority to have been
seized without due case, shall be deemed to have stolen the goods as if they were
the property of the Crown and shall be guilty of theft accordingly.

278 Notice of seizure

When any goods have been seized as forfeited the Manager at or nearest to
the place of seizure, or the Secretary shall, except when the goods are seized in the
presence of some person having or claiming an interest therein, give immediate
notice of the seizure, in the prescribed form, to the importer or some other person
known or believed to have an interest in the goods, either by delivering the notice
personally or by letter addressed to him and delivered at or transmitted by post
to his last-known place of abode or business, but no seizure shall be invalidated
or rendered illegal by any failure to give such notice.

Condemnation

279 Condemnation without suit

(1) All goods seized as forfeited shall be deemed to be condemned, as if by
suit and judgment of condemnation, unless within one month after the day of the
seizure some person gives notice in the prescribed form, verified by declaration
in the prescribed form, to the Manager at or nearest to the place of seizure or to
the Secretary, that he, or some one on whose behalf he acts, is entitled to the goods
or to an interest in them and intends to dispute their forfeiture.
708 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) The burden of proving in any proceedings that any such notice was duly given shall be on the person alleging it.
(3) Proceedings for the condemnation of any goods seized as forfeited may be commenced and prosecuted to judgment whether any such notice has been given or not.

280 Condemnation by High Court

(1) Proceedings for the condemnation of any goods seized as forfeited may
in any case be instituted in the High Court by information in rem by the Manager.
(2) The procedure on any such information shall, subject to this Act, be in
accordance with rules of court to be made in that behalf, and in default of such
rules, or so far as they do not extend, then under the usual practice of the High
Court in civil proceedings so far as applicable or, so far as not applicable, then on
the directions of the Court or a Judge of it.
(3) On the filing of any such information in the High Court by the Manager
notice of the proceedings shall be served on or given to such persons and in such
manner as the Court or a Judge of it directs.
(4) Any person claiming any interest in the goods to which the information
relates may within one month after the filing of the information, or within such
further time as the Court or a Judge allows, file a statement of defence, and shall
thereupon become a party to the proceedings.
(5) Every statement of defence shall set out the interest of the defendant in
the goods to which the information relates, and shall be accompanied by an
affidavit verifying the existence and nature of that interest.
(6) If no such statement of defence is duly filed by any person, judgment of
condemnation of the goods to which the information relates shall be entered.
(7) Every such information shall be heard and tried before a Judge alone,
unless the Court or a Judge is of opinion that it should be heard and tried before a
jury and makes an order accordingly.
(8) On any such information costs may be awarded to or against the
Manager or any other party to the proceedings.

281 No other action competent while condemnation proceedings pending

While any proceedings for condemnation are pending no action or other
proceedings for the recovery of damages for the seizure of or the detention of the
things seized, or for the recovery of possession of them, or for the recovery of
money deposited in lieu of them, or of the proceeds of their sale, shall be
commenced, or, if already commenced, shall be continued, without the leave of
the High Court.

282 [Repealed by 2004/270]

283 Conviction to operate as a condemnation of forfeited goods

(1) Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing provisions of this Part
relating to condemnation, but subject to subsection (2), when it is provided by
this Act or by any other of the Customs Acts that on the commission of any offence
any goods shall be forfeited, the conviction of any person of that offence shall
have effect as a condemnation, without suit or judgment, of any goods –
(a) That have been seized in accordance with this Act or with the Act under
which the forfeiture has accrued; and
(b) In respect of which the offence was committed.
(2) Subsection (1) shall not limit the right of any person, not being the
convicted person or a person acting on his behalf, to claim that he is entitled to the
goods or to an interest in them and to dispute their forfeiture under section 279.

Customs Act 1966

709

Miscellaneous Provisions

284 Delivery of goods seized on deposit of value

(1) When any goods have been seized as forfeited the Manager at or nearest
to the place of seizure may, if he thinks fit, at any time before their condemnation,
deliver them to the owner or other person from whom they were seized, on the
deposit with the Manager of a sum equal to their duty-paid value as determined
by the Manager.
(2) The money so deposited shall be deemed to be substituted for the goods
so seized, and all the provisions of this Act with respect to condemnation, so far as
they are applicable, shall extend and apply to that money accordingly as if a claim
thereto had been duly made under section 279 by the person depositing it.

285 Sale of perishable articles seized

(1) When any living creature or anything which, in the opinion of the
Manager, is of a perishable nature has been seized as forfeited the Manager at or
nearest to the place of seizure may, if he thinks fit, sell the thing so seized before
its condemnation.
(2) The net proceeds of such sale shall be deemed to be substituted for the
thing so sold, and all the provisions of this Act with respect to notice of claim and
condemnation shall apply to those proceeds accordingly.

286 Disposal of forfeited goods

All forfeited goods shall, on forfeiture, become the property of the Crown,
and shall be sold, destroyed, or otherwise disposed of as the Manager or the
Minister may direct.

287 [Repealed by 2004/270]

288 Application of forfeiture provisions

All the provisions of this Act with respect to the forfeiture of goods shall
extend and apply to any boat, vehicle, or other thing forfeited under the Customs
Acts.
PART 13
DETENTION OF SHIPS AND AIRCRAFT

289 Ships and aircraft liable to detention

Any ship or aircraft shall be liable to detention under this Part when any
offence has been committed for which the owner or master of the ship or the
owner or pilot in command of the aircraft is liable as such to a penalty under this
Act.

290 Seizure of ships and aircraft

(1) Any officer of Customs may seize any ship or aircraft that is liable to
detention under this Act or which he has reasonable and probable cause for
suspecting to be so liable.
(2) Any such seizure may be made in the same manner as a seizure of
forfeited goods.
(3) No ship or aircraft shall be so seized at any time except within 2 years
after the act or event that rendered it liable to detention.

291 Where ships and aircraft may be seized

No ship or aircraft shall be so seized elsewhere than within the territorial
limits of Niue.
710 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

292 Rescue of seized ships and aircraft

(1) Every person who, without the permission of the Manager or other
proper officer of Customs, whether under any claim or right or not, and either
secretly or openly, and whether with or without force or violence, takes away any
ship or aircraft seized as being liable to detention, at any time before it has been
declared by competent authority to have been seized without due cause, shall be
deemed to have stolen the ship or aircraft as if it were the property of the Crown,
and shall be guilty of theft accordingly.
(2) For the purposes of this section the seizure of any ship or aircraft shall
be deemed to be complete so soon as any officer of Customs has boarded the ship
or aircraft and notified the master or the pilot in command or any other officer of
the ship or aircraft that it is seized by the Customs, or so soon as any such officer
of Customs has been resisted or obstructed in his endeavour to board the ship or
aircraft for that purpose.

293 Security to be given before release of seized ship or aircraft

Every ship or aircraft so seized may be detained by the Customs until
security is given to the satisfaction of the Manager or Secretary in such sum as he
thinks sufficient, by or on behalf of the owner or master of the ship, or the owner
or pilot in command of the aircraft, or some person claiming an interest in it, for
the payment of any penalties and costs that may theretofore have been imposed
or may thereafter be imposed on that owner or master or pilot in respect of the
offence by which the liability of the ship or aircraft to detention accrued.

294 Avoidance of security

If no such penalty is imposed on the owner or master of the ship or the
owner or pilot in command of the aircraft either before or within one year after
the date of the seizure of the ship or aircraft, any such security shall become null
and void, and the ship or aircraft, if no such security has been given, shall cease to
be subject to detention.

295 Enforcement of security

If any such penalty is imposed on the owner or master of the ship or the
owner or pilot in command of the aircraft either before or within one year after
the date of the seizure of the ship or aircraft, any security so given shall become
available for the recovery of the amount of the penalty and of any costs awarded.

296 Service of process

For the purpose of recovering any such penalty, any writ, summons, or
other process may be served on the owner or master of any ship or the owner or
pilot in command of any aircraft so seized (whether the defendant is within Niue
or not) by leaving it or a copy of it on board the ship or aircraft; but nothing in this
section shall preclude any other lawful method of service.
PART 14
EVIDENCE

297 Incriminating questions and documents

(1) In any civil proceedings in any court under or in pursuance of any
provision of the Customs Acts, whether for the recovery of any duty or tax or in
relation to any forfeiture or otherwise, no person, whether a party to the
proceedings or not, shall be excused from answering any question put to him, by
interrogatory or otherwise, or from producing or making discovery of any
document, on the ground that the answer to the question or the production or
discovery of the document may incriminate or tend to incriminate him.

Customs Act 1966

711
(2) In any proceedings in any court for an offence against the Customs Acts, a person called as a witness (including a person charged with the offence and called as a witness on his own application) shall not be excused from answering any question put to him touching the alleged offence, on the ground that the answer may incriminate or tend to incriminate him.
(3) A statement made, in any proceedings to which subsection (1) or (2)
applies, by any person (other than the person charged with the offence in
proceedings to which the subsection (2) applies) in answer to any such question,
or a document of which production or discovery is so made by him in any such
civil proceedings, shall not, in any criminal proceedings, be admissible in evidence
against him except on a charge of perjury in respect of his sworn testimony or on
a charge of making a false statement on oath or on a charge of knowingly making
a false declaration under section 246.

298 Source of information need not be disclosed

No officer of Customs or constable and no witness for the Crown in any
prosecution for an offence against the Customs Acts, or in any proceedings relative
to the seizure, detention, or condemnation of ships, aircraft, or goods under those
Acts, shall be compellable to disclose the fact that he received any information, or
its nature or source, or to produce or disclose the existence or nature of any reports
made by or received by him in an official or confidential capacity.

299 Burden of proof

(1) In any proceedings against the Customs Acts instituted by or on behalf
of or against the Crown every allegation made on behalf of the Crown in any
statement of claim, statement of defence, plea, or information, and relating to the
identity or nature of any goods, or to their value for ad valorem duty, or to the
country or time of their exportation, or to the fact or time of their importation, or
to their place of manufacture, production, or origin, or to the payment of any duty
on them, or to any act done or omitted with respect to it by any person, shall be
presumed to be true unless the contrary is proved.
(2) The said presumption shall not be excluded by the fact that evidence is
produced on behalf of the Crown in support of any such allegation.
(3) For the purposes of this section a prosecution for an offence against the
Customs Acts shall be deemed to be a proceeding instituted on behalf of the Crown.
(4) For the purposes of this section, every proceeding instituted by or
against the Crown in which any question arises as to the rights, powers, obligations,
or liabilities of the Crown or any other person under the Customs Acts shall be
deemed to be a proceeding under those Acts.
(5) This section shall extend and apply to proceedings in which the
existence of an intent to defraud the revenue of Customs is in issue.

300 Burden of proof of justification

In all proceedings that are instituted against the Crown, or against the
Minister or an officer of Customs or a constable or any other person, for any seizure,
arrest or other act done in pursuance of the Customs Acts, and in which the
existence of reasonable or probable cause or of any other justification for such act
is in issue, the burden of proving the want of reasonable or probable cause or the
absence of such justification shall be on the plaintiff.
712 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

301 Presumption of authenticity of documents

All documents purporting to be signed by or on behalf of the Minister or
Secretary, or to be sealed with the seal of the Customs, shall in all courts and in all
proceedings under the Customs Acts be deemed to have been so signed or sealed
with due authority, unless the contrary is proved.

302 What evidence receivable

In any action or other proceeding under the Customs Acts, whether civil or
criminal (other than a prosecution for an indictable offence), the court may in
proof of any fact in issue admit and accept as sufficient such evidence as it thinks
fit, whether such evidence is legally admissible in other proceedings or not.

303 Declarations under this Act

(1) Every declaration required or authorised by this Act shall be made in
the prescribed form.
(2) Where by any such form it is indicated that the declaration shall be
made before any person, then it may be made before the Secretary or any Manager
or other officer of Customs, or before any postmaster or person for the time being
lawfully acting in the place of a postmaster or before any such other person as
may be prescribed.
PART 15
COOK ISLANDS AND NEW ZEALAND

304 Goods imported from Cook Islands and New Zealand

(1) All goods imported into Niue from the Cook Islands or New Zealand,
whether the produce or manufacture of the Cook Islands or New Zealand or not,
shall be admitted into Niue free of duty.
(2) Nothing in this section shall apply to –
(a) Goods in respect of which on their exportation from the Cook
Islands or New Zealand any claim for drawback of duty has been
made and allowed;
(b) Goods which, by reason of warehousing or for any other reason,
have been exported from the Cook Islands or New Zealand without
payment of duty on their importation into the Cook Islands or New
Zealand;
(c) Goods produced in a manufacturing warehouse in the Cook Islands
or New Zealand, unless they have been entered in the Cook Islands
or New Zealand for home consumption and the duty (if any) paid
on it;
(d) Goods on which a rate of duty has been paid in the Cook Islands or
New Zealand lower than that to which the goods are subject in
New Zealand at the time of their importation into New Zealand;
(e) Goods subject to any excise duty in the Cook Islands or New
Zealand, unless such duty has been paid thereon as if they had not
been exported.
PART 16
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

305 Goods passing through Post Office

(1) Subject to this section and to any regulations made under this Act, the
provisions of the Customs Acts shall apply to postal packets and to goods contained
therein in the same manner as to any other goods.

Customs Act 1966

713
(2) Without limiting the power to make regulations conferred by section
306, Cabinet may make regulations for the following purposes –
(a) Modifying any provisions of the Customs Acts in their application
to postal packets or to goods contained therein, or exempting such
postal packets or goods from the application of any provisions of
the Customs Acts, but not so as to affect the liability of any goods
to duty or the rate of any duty or the law as to prohibited imports
or exports;
(b) Securing, in respect of such packets or goods, the observance of the
Customs Acts and the payment of duty;
(c) Enabling the officers of the Post Office to exercise or perform for
the purpose of the Customs Acts all or any of the powers or duties
of the importer or exporter, or of officers of Customs, in respect of
such packets or goods;
(d) Authorising the destruction or other mode of disposition of postal
packets or goods in there on which duty is not paid within such
time as may be prescribed;
(e) Providing that any separate postal packets and any goods in it,
whether addressed to the same or to different persons, may be
treated for the purposes of the Customs Acts as a single package
consigned to a single person, and that duty shall be payable thereon
accordingly;
(f) Prescribing the persons who shall be deemed for the purposes of
the Customs Acts to be the importers or exporters of such postal
packets or goods.
(3) In this section, “postal packet” means any letter, parcel, packet, or other
article whatever received or transmitted by or through the Post Office.

306 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations for the following purposes –
(a) Prescribing the nature, size and material of the packages in which
imported goods or goods for export or for removal within Niue are
to be packed;
(b) Prescribing the maximum weight or quantity of imported goods or
goods for export or for removal within Niue that may be contained
in any one package;
(c) Prescribing the conditions of preparation or manufacture for export
of any articles used for food or drink by man or used in the
manufacture of articles so used;
(d) Prescribing the conditions as to purity, soundness, and freedom
from disease to be conformed to by goods for export;
(e) Prescribing the manner in which goods shall be weighed or
measured for the purposes of the Customs Acts, and the allowances
or deductions that may be permitted in such weighing or measuring;
(f) Modifying any provisions of the Customs Acts in their application
to goods (not being goods passing through the Post Office) that are
imported into Niue or exported from Niue by means of aircraft,
but not so as to affect the liability of any goods to duty or the rate of
any duty or the law as to prohibited imports or exports;
(g) Prescribing forms for the purposes of this Act;
(h) Providing for such matters as are contemplated by or necessary for
giving full effect to the provisions of the Customs Acts and for the
due administration thereof.
714 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

307 Penalties imposed by regulations

Any regulations made under this Act may prescribe fines, not exceeding in
any case 2 penalty units for the breach of any such regulations.

308 Regulations

No regulation under this Act shall be invalid because it leaves any matter
to the discretion of the Minister or of any other person, or because it authorises
the Minister or any other person to give any consent or to issue any licence, permit,
or other instrument on or subject to conditions to be imposed or approved by the
Minister.

309-313 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Section 48 (1)

Customs Act 1966

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

PROHIBITED IMPORTS

715

Matches made with white phosphorus. All indecent documents and articles.

False or counterfeit coin or banknotes; and any coin that is not of the established standard in weight or composition; and any coin or banknotes that are intended for circulation in Niue and are not legal tender in Niue.

Goods manufactured or produced wholly or in part by prison labour, or within or in connection with any prison, jail, or penitentiary; also goods similar in character to those manufactured or produced in such institutions when sold or offered for sale by any person, firm, or corporation having a contract for the manufacture or production of such articles in such institutions, or by any agent of such person, firm, or corporation, or when originally purchased from or transferred by any such contractor.

–––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 2

THE CUSTOMS TARIFF OF NIUE

[Not reproduced, see now Customs Tariff Regulations 1982]

––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 3

EXCISE DUTIES

Section 134 (1) (a)

Goods Unit Rates of Duty

Alcohol used in manufacturing warehouses

in the production of –

Perfumed spirit per proof 1 80c

Toilet preparations per proof 1 75c

Culinary and flavouring essences per proof 1 44c

Medicaments (except medicated wine or

wine mixed with food):

Containing more than 50% of proof spirit per proof 1 10c

Other Free

Cigarette tubes, cigarette papers, and per 1,000 tubes or

Cigarette paper manufactured in a 1.000 papers or

Manufacturing warehouse equivalent of

1,000 tubes or 7c

papers

Sugar of any degree of polarisation Free

Invert sugar and invert syrup Free

Liquid sugar solution:

On weight of sugar contained in the

solution as determined by means

of the Brix hydrometer or other

similar instrument Free

Treacle, molasses, golden syrup, maple

sugar and maple syrup

Free

Tobacco, manufactured:

Cigars and snuff

per kg

$6.57

716 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Cigarettes:

Not exceeding in weight 1.134 kg

Per 1,000

Exceeding in weight 1.134 kg

Other manufactured tobacco

per 1,000 per kg per kg

$11.90

$10.49

$7.80

––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 4 [Repealed by 2004/270]

––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 5

CUSTOMS WARRANT

Section 216 (1)

To

Under the Customs Act 1966, you are hereby authorised to enter by day or night, and whether peaceably or by force if need be, any house, premises, or place in which you have reasonable cause to suspect that there are any uncustomed goods, or any goods subject to the control of the Customs or unlawfully imported, or any goods in respect of which an offence has been committed against the Customs Acts, or any books or other documents relating to any such goods, or any books or other documents containing information that may lead to the recovery of any penalty or other money under the Customs Acts, and to search any house, premises, or place so entered, and there to break open and search any boxes, receptacles, packages, or places in which any such goods, books, or documents may be or be supposed to be; and on any such entry to seize and take away any forfeited goods or any goods which there is reasonable cause to believe or suspect to be forfeited; and in so acting you are hereby authorised to take with you and have the assistance of any Constable and such other assistants as you deem necessary. For all which this shall be your sufficient warrant.

Given under my hand and the seal of the Customs, this day of 20 (Customs Sean( �/p>

Financial Secretary, Customs

717

CUSTOMS TARIFF ACT 1982

1982/77 - 30 September 1982

1

Short title

6

Regulations

2

Interpretation

7

Modification of Tariff

3

Customs Tariff

8

Exemptions from duties

4

[Spent]

9

Procedures for making applications for

5

Duties to be levied

exemptions

1 Short title

This is the Customs Tariff Act 1982 and shall be read together with and
deemed part of the Customs Act 1966 (‘the Principal Act’).

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“regulations” means the regulations made under section 3.

3 Customs Tariff

Cabinet shall by regulation prepare a Customs Tariff setting out the Customs
duties to be levied and collected on all goods imported into Niue.

4 [Spent]

5 Duties to be levied

(1) Subject to this Act and the Principal Act, customs duties shall be levied,
collected and paid under the regulations made under section 3 on all goods
imported into Niue or entered therein for home consumption.
(2) All duties levied, collected and paid under the regulations shall be
deemed to have satisfied all requirements to levy, collect and pay duties under
Schedule 2 of the Principal Act.

6 Regulations

Regulations made under this Act need not be printed in the Niuean language
unless Cabinet otherwise determines.

7 Modification of tariff

Cabinet may by regulation modify in whole or in part the Customs Tariff
contained in the regulations following the procedure prescribed in section 6.

8 Exemption from duties

(1) Notwithstanding the rates of duty specified in the Customs Tariff,
Cabinet is empowered to make exemptions for payment of duties or to substitute
reduced rates of duties.
718 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1) Cabinet shall determine the activities for which duty exemptions may be granted and the conditions for granting exemptions.

9 Procedures for making applications for exemption

(1) All applications for exemptions are in the first instance to be made
through the Revenue Manager.
(2) On receipt of an application and any further information that the
Revenue Manager may require, the Revenue Manager shall, as soon as possible
and in no case later than 14 days from the date of receipt of such application,
forward the application to the Minister of Customs and to the relevant department
for comment, as the case may require, together with appropriate recommendations.
719

DEATHS BY ACCIDENTS COMPENSATION ACT 1952

1952/35 (NZ) – 1 January 1953

1

Short title

PART 2

2

Interpretation

APPORTIONMENT OF DAMAGES

3

Act to bind the Crown

11

Interpretation

12

Costs, medical and funeral expenses

PART 1

13

Damages may be allotted

ACTIONS FOR DAMAGES

14

Disposition of damages

4

Right of action when death is caused by 15

Class fund

negligence

16

Power to authorise advances

5

Action to be for benefit of family

17

Variation of orders

6

Persons who may bring action

18

Considerations to be taken into account

7

Amount of damages

19

Persons who may apply for order

8

Plaintiff to deliver full particulars

20

[Spent]

9

Money paid into Court

21-22 [Repealed]

10

Limitation of actions

PART 3

23

[Repealed]

To consolidate and amend certain enactments relating to actions for damages on behalf of the families of persons killed by accident

1 Short title

This is the Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“child”, in relation to any deceased person, means a son, daughter,
grandson, granddaughter, stepson, or stepdaughter of the deceased
person;
“dependant”, in relation to any deceased person, means any wife, husband,
parent, or child of that person who has suffered injury as a result of the
death of the deceased person or who might reasonably have expected
to enjoy some actual pecuniary benefit if the deceased person had not
died, whether or not the wife, husband, parent, or child was either
wholly or partially dependent upon the deceased person before his
death;
“parent”, in relation to any deceased person, means a father, mother,
grandfather, grandmother, stepfather, or stepmother of the deceased
person;
“wife”, in relation to any deceased person, means the person who is his
wife at his death; and includes every other person who has been his
wife and is maintained or entitled to be maintained by him either wholly
720 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
or partly at the time of his death or would have been so maintained or entitled but for the incapacity due to the accident from which his death resulted.
(2) For the purposes of this Act, in deducing any relationship which is included within the meaning of “parent” and “child” any illegitimate person and any person legally adopted outside Niue shall be treated as being, or as having been, the legitimate offspring of his mother and reputed father or, as the case may be, his adopters.

3 Act to bind the Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.
PART 1
ACTIONS FOR DAMAGES

4 Right of action when death is caused by negligence

(1) Where the death of a person is caused by any wrongful act, neglect, or
default, and the act, neglect, or default is such as would (if death had not ensued)
have entitled the party injured to maintain an action and recover damages in respect
of it, the person who would have been liable if death had not ensured shall be
liable to an action for damages, notwithstanding the death of the person injured,
and although the death was caused under such circumstances as to amount in
law to a crime.
(2) [Spent]
(3) Not more than one action shall lie under this Act for the same subject-
matter of complaint.

5 Action to be for benefit of family

Every such action shall be for the benefit of the wife or husband and the
parents and children of the person whose death has been so caused.

6 Persons who may bring action

(1) (a) Every such action shall be brought by and in the name of the
executor or administrator of the deceased person.
(b) Where no action is so brought within 6 months after the date of the
death of the deceased person, or where within 6 months after the
date of the death of the deceased person, the executor or
administrator declares in writing his desire not to bring the action,
or where there is for the time being no executor or administrator of
the deceased person, the action may be brought by and in the name
of the person, or (if there are more than one) the names of all or of
any of the persons, for whose benefit the action would have been if
it had been brought by and in the name of the executor or
administrator.
(2) Where any such action is brought by and in the name of any person or
persons other than the executor or administrator of the deceased person, the action
shall be for the benefit of the same person or persons, and shall be subject to the
same procedure, as nearly as may be, as if it were brought by and in the name of
the executor or administrator.

Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952

721

7 Amount of damages

(1) In every such action the Court may award –
(a) Such damages as it may think proportioned to the injury resulting
from the death to the person or persons for whose benefit the action
is brought; and
(b) Damages in respect of the amount of actual pecuniary benefit which
the person or persons for whose benefit the action is brought might
reasonably have expected to enjoy if the death had not occurred,
whether or not the person or persons have been either wholly or
partially dependent upon the deceased person before his death;
and
(c) Damages in respect of the medical and funeral expenses of the
deceased person if the expenses have been incurred by the person
or any of the persons by whom or for whose benefit the action is
brought.
(2) In awarding damages in any such action the court shall not take into
account any gain, whether to the estate of the deceased person or to any dependant,
that is consequent on the death of the deceased person.

8 Plaintiff to deliver full particulars

In every such action the plaintiff on the record shall be required to deliver
to the defendant or his solicitor, in or together with the statement of claim, full
particulars of the person or persons for whose benefit the action is brought, and of
the nature of the claim in respect of which damages are sought to be recovered.

9 Money paid into Court

If the defendant pays money into court, it shall be sufficient if he pays it in
one sum for the benefit of all persons entitled under this Act as a compensation
for his wrongful act, neglect, or default, without specifying the shares into which
it is to be divided.

10 Limitation of actions

(1) Except as provided in this section, no action shall be brought under
this Act after the expiration of 2 years from the date of the death of the deceased
person.
(2) Application may be made to the court, after notice to the intended
defendant, for leave to bring such an action at any time within 6 years from the
date of the death of the deceased person; and the court may grant leave accordingly,
subject to such conditions (if any) as it thinks it is just to impose, where it considers
that the delay in bringing the action was occasioned by mistake or by any other
reasonable cause or that the intended defendant was not materially prejudiced in
his defence or otherwise by the delay.
(3) Where any person who is under a disability at the date of the death of
the deceased person is entitled, under the proviso to section 6(1), to bring an action
in respect of that death, that action may be brought, without the leave of the court,
within 2 years from the date when he ceased to be under a disability or sooner
died, or an application for leave to bring that action may be made under section
6(2) within 6 years from the date when he ceased to be under a disability or sooner
died, if when the action (without such leave) is commenced or the application is
made, as the case may be –
722 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(a) No other person has commenced an action under this Act in respect of the death of the deceased person or made an application for leave to bring such an action; and
(b) No grant of administration has been made in Niue in respect of the estate.
(4) For the purposes of this section, a person shall be deemed to be under
a disability while he is an infant or of unsound mind.

11 Interpretation

PART 2
APPORTIONMENT OF DAMAGES
For the purposes of this Part –
(a) ”trustee” means the trustee appointed by the Court;
(b) without prejudice to the generality of the expression “of unsound
mind”, a person shall be conclusively presumed to be of unsound
mind while he is detained or kept in custody (otherwise than as a
voluntary inpatient) under Part 26 of the Niue Act 1966.

12 Costs, medical and funeral expenses

Where any damages for which an action lies under this Act are recovered
(either in an action or without any action being brought), the costs which are
properly payable out of the damages and are not otherwise recovered may be
paid thereout, and the amount (if any) recovered in respect of the medical and
funeral expenses of the deceased person may be refunded to the person or persons
who paid them, and the balance of the damages may be allotted or disposed of by
the court as provided in this Part.

13 Damages may be allotted

(1) Where the court makes an order under this Part and is satisfied that
there was only one dependant of the deceased person, the balance of the damages
shall be allotted to that dependant.
(2) Where the court makes an order under this Part and is satisfied that
there were 2 or more dependants, the court may order –
(a) That the balance of the damages or so much thereof as it may specify
shall be allotted to any dependant exclusively, or shall be allotted
in such proportions as the court determines among the dependants
or among such 2 or more of them to the exclusion of the other or
others of them as the court specifies;
(b) That the balance of the damages or so much thereof as it may specify
shall be held on trust as a class fund for the benefit of the dependants
or of such 2 or more of them to the exclusion of the other or others
of them as the court specifies.

14 Disposition of damages

(1) Where any amount is allotted to a dependant under section 13, that
amount shall be paid to him unless he is an infant or of unsound mind or except
in so far as the court orders that the whole or any part of that amount shall be held
on trust under subsection (2).
(2) Where any amount is allotted to any dependant who is an infant or of
unsound mind or the court orders that the whole or any part of the amount allotted
to a dependant is to be held on trust for that dependant under this subsection,
then, except so far as the court directs any immediate payment therefrom, and
subject to any directions or conditions given or imposed by the court –

Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952

723
(a) The amount shall be invested and held by the trustee upon trust – (i) to make such payments (if any) to the dependant out of the income and capital of the amount as the court may specify;
and
(ii) to apply the income and capital of the amount or so much of it
as the trustee thinks fit for or towards the maintenance or
education (including past maintenance or education provided
after the death of the deceased person) or the advancement or
benefit of the dependant;
(b) The dependant shall have no power, either by himself or in
conjunction with any other person or persons, to terminate the trusts
upon which the amount is held or to modify or extinguish those
trusts;
(c) The interest of the dependant in the income and capital of the
amount shall not, while it remains in the hands of the trustee, be
alienated, or pass by bankruptcy, or be liable to be seized, sold,
attached, or taken in execution by process of law.
(3) (a) Upon any dependant ceasing to be an infant or of unsound mind
while any amount is held on trust for his benefit under subsection
(2), the balance of that amount and of the income from it remaining
in the hands of the trustee shall be paid to the dependant except in
so far as the court may have ordered before the payment is made
that the whole or any part of that amount shall continue to be held
on trust under that subsection;
(b) Where the trustee has notice that an application has been made to
the court for such an order he shall not make any payment under
this subsection until the application has been disposed of.
(4) (a) The court may order that, if any dependant dies while any amount
allotted to him is held on trust under subsection (2) (whether or not
he is an infant or of unsound mind) any balance of the amount and
of the income from it remaining in the hands of the trustee at his
death, or so much of it as the court may specify, shall form part of
the dependant’s estate, or shall be added to the amount allotted to
any other dependant or to the amounts allotted to all or any of the
other dependants in such proportions as the court may specify or
to any class fund set aside out of the balance of the damages, and
shall be subject to the trusts of the amount or amounts or fund to
which it is added.
(b) If and so far as that balance is not wholly disposed of under any
order of the court made during the lifetime of the dependant for
whose benefit it had been held, or made on an application to the
court made not later than 6 months after that dependant’s death, it
shall form part of his estate.

15 Class fund

Where any amount is to be held on trust as a class fund for any dependants
under section 13(2), that amount shall be invested and the trustee may, but subject to such directions and conditions as the court may give or impose, apply the income and capital of that amount or so much of it as the trustee thinks fit for or towards the maintenance or education (including past maintenance or education provided after the death of the deceased person) or the advancement or benefit of those dependants or of any one or more of them to the exclusion of the other or others of
724 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
them in such shares and proportions and generally in such manner as the trustee thinks fit; and may so apply the income and capital of that amount notwithstanding that only one of those dependants remains alive.

16 Power to authorise advances

(1) The court may authorise moneys to be advanced to any dependant
(whether by way of loan or otherwise) as it thinks fit and upon or subject to such
conditions as it thinks fit, out of the damages or out of any amounts allotted to
other dependants or out of any amount held on trust as a class fund, for any
purpose that the court thinks proper in the interests of the dependants or any of
them.
(2) Without limiting the generality of this section, it is hereby declared that any such advance may be made for the purpose of purchasing or otherwise acquiring a residential property for the use of the dependant either alone or in conjunction with any other dependants, or for the purpose of repaying any moneys secured by way of mortgage or otherwise on any residential property owned by the dependant and so used, or for the purpose of furnishing any such residential property.
(3) (a) Where moneys are advanced by way of loan, the court may give such directions in respect of the security to be taken, and may either prescribe the conditions upon or subject to which the moneys are to be advanced or authorise the trustee to prescribe the conditions at his discretion.
(b) The conditions may include power to the trustee to remit interest
and principal moneys or any part thereof to the extent of the amount
or value of any maintenance, education, advancement, or benefit
which the dependant to whom the moneys are advanced may
provide for any other dependants.

17 Variation of orders

The Court may vary any order made by it in respect of damages which
have been recovered (either in an action or without an action being brought) under
this Act and in respect of the income from it so far as the damages and income are
for the time being in the hands of the trustee.

18 Considerations to be taken into account

In making or varying an order under this Part the court shall have regard
to all relevant considerations including, where the damages are recovered in an
action which is tried with a jury, any recommendation which the jury may make
in respect of the order; and the court may when it considers that it is just and
proper to do so, take into consideration all or any of the following matters –
(a) Any gain to any dependant that is consequent on the death of the
deceased person; and
(b) Circumstances which have arisen after the date of the death of the
deceased person; and
(c) The probable future needs of the dependants.

19 Persons who may apply for order

An order or variation of an order under this Part may be made by the court
of its own motion or on an application made by –
(a) Any dependant of the deceased person;
(b) The husband or wife of any such dependant;

Deaths by Accidents Compensation Act 1952

725
(c) Any near relation by blood or marriage of any such dependant; (d) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(e) The trustee who holds the amount to which the application relates;
or
(f) Any other person who adduces proof of circumstances which in
the opinion of the court make it proper that he should make the
application.

20 [Spent]

21-22 [Repealed by 2004/270]

23 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 3

726 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

727

DEPARTURE TAX ACT 1996

1996/212 – 3 October 1996

1

Short title

5

Recovery of departure tax

2

Interpretation

6

Offences

3

Departure tax

7

Regulations

4

Collection of departure tax

8

[Spent]

To impose tax upon travellers departing from Niue and to provide for its collection

1 Short title

This is the Departure Tax Act 1996.

2 Interpretation

In this Act and its regulations –
“Act” means the Departure Tax Act 1996;
“child” means a person of 2 years of age and up to the age of 12 years;
“diplomat” means a person who has accredited diplomatic status
recognised by the Niue Government together with that person’s
immediate family;
“infant” means a person under the age of 2 years;
“transit passenger” means a passenger who –
(i) does not leave the airport or ship; or
(ii) leaves the airport or vessel only because of an interruption to
the journey caused by unserviceability of that aircraft or vessel,
or caused by any other delay beyond the control of the
passenger or the operator concerned; or
(iii) stays on Niue solely for the purpose of securing onward travel
to a country other than that from which the person arrived from,
and departs Niue within 12 hours of arrival.

3 Departure tax

(1) Subject to subsection (2) every person departing Niue shall pay a
departure tax.
(2) The following persons shall not be liable to pay departure tax imposed
by subsection (1) –
(a) Any member of the crew of a scheduled, military, diplomatic, or
licensed commercial aircraft or vessel;
(b) An infant or child;
(c) Any diplomat together with any member of his immediate family;
and
(d) Any transit passenger.
728 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

4 Collection of tax

(1) The Customs Department of Treasury, or any other person duly
authorised by that department, shall be responsible for the collecting and receipting
of all departure tax imposed on persons departing Niue.
(2) The Customs Department may direct any travel agent to collect
departure tax on their behalf.
(3) Any person required to pay departure tax shall not be permitted to
depart Niue without first paying departure tax.
(4) All departure tax shall be paid in cash in New Zealand dollars or the
cash equivalent in the currency of either Australia or the United States of America.

5 Recovery of departure tax

Should any person, liable for payment of departure tax, fail to make such
payment, then the Niue Government may recover such tax in any court of
competent jurisdiction.

6 Offences

(1) Any person who fails to comply with or acts in contravention of this
Act or any regulations thereunder commits an offence.
(2) Any person who knowingly makes a false or misleading statement in,
or in connection with, any return to be furnished under this Act or any regulations
made thereunder commits an offence.
(3) Any person who commits an offence against this Act or any regulations
made thereunder, for which no other penalty is prescribed, shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 2 years.

7 Regulations

(1) Subject to this Act, Cabinet may make such regulations as may be
necessary or expedient for giving effect to this Act and for its due administration.
(2) Without limiting the general power conferred by subsection (1),
regulations may be made under this section –
(a) For exempting certain persons or classes of persons from payment
of departure tax;
(b) Prescribing forms or stamps required to certify and receipt payments
of departure tax;
(c) Prescribing penalties for any breach of this Act or regulations made
under it.

8 [Spent]

729

DEVELOPMENT INVESTMENT ACT 1992

1992/164 – 1 October 1992

20 Variation, suspension and revocation of concessions

PART 5

DISCLOSURE AND FILING OF INFORMATION

21 Disclosure and filing

PART 6

GUARANTEES TO FOREIGN ENTERPRISES

22 Guarantees to foreign enterprises

PART 7

JUDICIAL REVIEW

23 Application for review

24 Defects in form

25 Interim orders

26 Sufficiency of application

37-38 [Spent]

SCHEDULES


730 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

To introduce a development and investment incentive scheme and to regulate foreign investment in Niue

1 Short title

This is the Development Investment Act 1992.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“activity” means an undertaking of whatever nature engaged in by an
enterprise and includes each and every other undertaking that is
associated with or incidental to that undertaking;
“book and document” and “book or document” includes all books,
accounts, records, registers, rolls, computer tapes, discs, and printouts;
“carry on business” means to be engaged in an activity for the principal
purpose of deriving a gain from that activity whether such gain is
pecuniary or otherwise, but does not include –
(a) An isolated transaction, not being one of a number of similar
transactions repeated from time to time;
(b) Maintaining a bank account in Niue;
(c) Taking security for or collecting any debt or enforcing any rights
relating to any security;
(d) The gathering of any information or undertaking a feasibility study;
“Code” means the Investment Code published under Part 4;
“employee” means any person who receives or is entitled to receive a source
deduction payment under the Income Tax Act 1961;
“enterprise” means any person carrying on business or proposing to carry
on business;
“existing activity” means an activity being carried on immediately before
the commencement of this Act;
“foreign enterprise” means –
(a) In the case of an enterprise that is a body corporate, an enterprise –
(i) (a) in which 50 percent or more of the voting shares or power
is held or controlled by persons who are not local persons;
and,
(b) in which 50 percent or more of the value or number of the
shares are beneficially owned or controlled by persons who
are not local persons; or,
(ii) that does not have its central management or control in Niue.
(b) In the case of an enterprise other than a body corporate, an
enterprise –
(i) in which 50 percent or more of the members or partners are
not local persons; or
(ii) in which 50 per cent or more of the beneficial ownership of
which is owned by persons who are not local persons.
(c) An enterprise that is a person other than a local person –
“foreign interest” means –
(a) In the case of an enterprise that is a body corporate, the interest
being –
(i) the voting shares or power held or controlled by persons who
are not local persons; or
(ii) the value or number of shares beneficially owned or controlled
by persons who are not local persons;

Development Investment Act 1992

731
(b) In the case of an enterprise other than a body corporate the interest in which the beneficial ownership is owned or controlled by persons who are not local persons;
“local enterprise” means an enterprise other than a foreign enterprise; “local person” means –
(a) A Niuean;
(b) A person who has the status of a permanent resident under section
6 of the Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985;
“share” includes any legal or beneficial interest in the capital or investments
of a company;
“shareholder” includes any member of a body corporate whether its capital
is divided into shares or not;
“trustee” includes an executor or administrator.
(2) Where in the opinion of Cabinet the activity in which an enterprise is
engaged is primarily for a religious, educational, charitable or community purpose,
Cabinet may exempt that enterprise from all or any of the provisions of this Act
on such conditions as Cabinet thinks fit.

3 Purposes of Act

PART 1
GENERAL
The purposes of this Act are to –
(a) Promote, foster and assist the establishment of enterprises generally
in Niue;
(b) Encourage investment activity that will make the best use of
resources consistent with national development and investment
policies;
(c) Regulate and control the direction, extent and scope of foreign
investment;
(d) Facilitate the participation of local persons in investment and in
the ownership, management and control of enterprises.

4 Application of Act

(1) The provisions of the –
(a) Income Tax Act 1961;
(b) Customs Act 1966;
(c) Customs Tariff Act 1982;
(d) Entry Residence and Departure Act 1985;
shall be subject to this Act and every decision of Cabinet made under this Act
shall override any decision made by Cabinet or any Minister under any of those
Acts.
(2) Nothing in this Act shall derogate from any other power of control of investment or employment under any other Act, except that no such power shall be exercised in a manner inconsistent with this Act.
(3) Registration of a foreign enterprise under this Act shall not of itself relieve the enterprise from compliance with any other Act.

5 Act binding on Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.
732 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
PART 2
REGULATION OF FOREIGN ENTERPRISES

6 Restriction on carrying on business by foreign enterprise

No foreign enterprise shall carry on business in Niue in any activity unless
that foreign enterprise is registered under this Act to carry on business in respect
of that activity.

7 [Spent]

8 Registration

(1) No foreign enterprise shall carry on business in Niue in any activity
unless it has first applied to and is registered by Cabinet under this section as a
foreign enterprise to carry on business in respect of that activity.
(2) Every application made to Cabinet under subsection (1) shall contain
full particulars of –
(a) The name of the enterprise;
(b) The address of its registered office and principal place of business;
(c) The proposed activities in respect of which registration is sought;
(d) The names and addresses of its shareholders, or partners, directors,
executive officers, secretary, accountant and auditor or of the persons
carrying out those functions;
(e) The legal and beneficial ownership of authorised, issued and paid-
up capital, and the number, class, nominal and paid-up shares held
by each shareholder:
Provided that where the enterprise has not divided its capital into shares, the
information shall relate to any beneficial interest in the capital and profits of the
enterprise held by or on behalf of any person or a trustee of any beneficiary;
(f) Particulars of proposed capital expenditure together with the
sources and forms of financing of the enterprise;
(g) A balance sheet setting out its assets and liabilities;
(h) The number of local persons and expatriate persons to be employed,
and the provision for the training of local persons;
(i) The proposed activity to be undertaken and the nature and source
of raw materials to be used;
(j) Such other information as Cabinet may require.
(3) When considering an application, Cabinet shall take into account the
criteria set out in the Investment Code and may either –
(a) Approve the application with or without such terms and conditions
as Cabinet may impose; or
(b) Decline the application.
(4) Where Cabinet approves an application without imposing any terms
and conditions the applicant shall be registered as a foreign enterprise to carry on
business in respect of the specified activity or activities.
(5) Where Cabinet approves an application subject to terms and conditions
the applicant shall notify Cabinet whether such terms and conditions are acceptable
and in the event that they are, Cabinet shall register the applicant as a foreign
enterprise to carry on business in respect of such activities as shall have been
approved by Cabinet.

Development Investment Act 1992

733

9 Issue of certificate of registration

On registration of an enterprise as a foreign enterprise to carry on business
in respect of an activity or activities under this Part, Cabinet shall issue to the
enterprise a certificate of registration setting out the name of the foreign enterprise
and the activity or activities in respect of which it is approved to carry on business.

10 Variation of registration

Upon application being made to Cabinet by a foreign enterprise registered
under this Act, Cabinet may vary all or any of the terms or conditions of the
registration of the foreign enterprise.

11 Revocation of registration

(1) Where a foreign enterprise has –
(a) Contravened any of the provisions of this Act; or
(b) Failed to comply with any term or conditions of its registration as a
foreign enterprise,
and Cabinet, after due enquiry and having regard to the nature of the contravention
or failure, considers that it is undesirable that the enterprise should continue to be
registered under this Act, or registered in respect of a particular activity, Cabinet
shall notify the foreign enterprise of its opinion and of the reasons for such opinion,
and shall invite the foreign enterprise to make representations within a period
specified by Cabinet, being in any event not less than 21 days, as to why registration
of the enterprise as a foreign enterprise under this Act should not be revoked,
either wholly or in respect of any particular activity.
(2) Upon receipt of any representations made under subsection (1), and
after due consideration of those representations or, on expiry of the specified period
if no such representations are made, Cabinet may revoke the registration of the
foreign enterprise either –
(a) Wholly; or
(b) In respect of any particular activity.
(3) Where Cabinet revokes the registration of a foreign enterprise under
subsection (2), either wholly or in respect of any particular activity, Cabinet shall
give notice to the foreign enterprise of its decision and of the reasons for such
decision.
(4) The revocation of the registration of a foreign enterprise under
subsection (2) shall not in any way affect any liability of that foreign enterprise to
its creditors or to any person interested in the affairs of the foreign enterprise, or
the rights of such creditors or persons, whether or not the liability or right shall
have arisen before or after the date that the revocation shall take effect.

12 Continuation of business

No foreign enterprise shall carry on business in Niue in any activity after
revocation of registration in respect of that activity has taken effect, except insofar
as is necessary for the enterprise to wind up its affairs in relation to that activity,
but in any event not exceeding 3 months, or such extended time as Cabinet may
allow.
734 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

13 Transfer of shares

PART 3
CONTROL OF TAKEOVERS
(1) A transfer of the legal or equitable interest in shares or any proprietary interest in an enterprise –
(a) Where that transfer has the effect of the enterprise becoming a
foreign enterprise; or
(b) Where that transfer has the effect of increasing the foreign interest
in an enterprise that is a foreign enterprise,
shall not be valid or of any effect unless the approval of Cabinet to such transfer
or increase has first been obtained.
(2) An increase in the share capital or any proprietary interest of an
enterprise where –
(a) The increase shall have the effect of the enterprise becoming a
foreign enterprise; or
(b) Where the enterprise is a foreign enterprise, the increased capital is
issued –
(i) to a subscriber who is not a local person or a local enterprise;
or
(ii) to existing shareholders other than in the same proportion as,
and upon the same terms, conditions and rights as, their existing
shareholding,
shall not be valid or of any effect, unless the approval of Cabinet to such increase
has first been obtained.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (1), any matter or thing (whether in
Niue or elsewhere) having the effect of altering the effective ownership or control
of any enterprise which has a direct or indirect interest in any enterprise carrying
on business in Niue; including –
(a) The transfer of shares or any proprietary interest;
(b) The issue of new shares;
(c) Any change in the governing rules,
shall be deemed for the purposes of this Act to be a transfer of shares in the
enterprise carrying on business in Niue.
(4) Where the approval of Cabinet is sought for the purposes of this section,
the enterprise concerned or any interested party shall apply to Cabinet in writing,
setting out details of the proposed increase or transfer of shares and particulars of
the parties involved.
(5) Cabinet may in granting any approval under this section impose such
terms and conditions it thinks fit.
(6) The approval of Cabinet to a transfer of shares or proprietary interest
shall not be withheld where, before the transfer or increase or alteration, the
transferor or the enterprise has taken all reasonable steps to endeavour to transfer
the shares or proprietary interest or new capital, to a local person or local enterprise.

14 Change in status

Where a foreign enterprise registered under this Act becomes a local
enterprise Cabinet shall, on being satisfied of the change in status, deregister the
enterprise as a foreign enterprise.

Development Investment Act 1992

735
PART 4
INVESTMENT PRIORITIES AND INCENTIVES

15 Investment Code

(1) Cabinet shall determine and publish in the Gazette, an Investment Code.
(2) The purpose of the Code shall be to inform potential investors as well
as persons or bodies responsible for planning, promoting or encouraging
investment in Niue of the priorities and reservations attached by Cabinet to
investment in particular activities.
(3) The Code shall include particulars of –
(a) Investments and activities which merit encouragement;
(b) Activities which may be eligible for incentives and concessions to
be approved under section 17(3);
(c) General criteria by which any investment or new enterprise will be
evaluated to determine its merits;
(d) Criteria by which foreign investment or a foreign enterprise will be
evaluated;
(e) The kinds of activities reserved for local enterprises;
(f) Such other matters as Cabinet may decide.

16 Investment incentives and concessions

(1) Incentives and concessions as specified in the Schedule to this Act are
hereby established and shall be capable of being granted by Cabinet
notwithstanding any other enactment to the contrary.
(2) Cabinet may by regulation, amend, delete from or add to the Schedule,
such incentives and concessions as Cabinet may determine.
(3) All regulations made under this section shall be laid before the Assembly
forthwith after the making of it if the Assembly is then in session, and if not, shall
be laid before the Assembly at the commencement of the next ensuing session.

17 Application for incentives and concessions

(1) An enterprise carrying on business in an activity which is eligible for
incentives and concessions under the Investment Code may apply to Cabinet to
be granted the incentives and concessions established by this Act.
(2) Every application to Cabinet shall include, where applicable, the
following information –
(a) The nature of the enterprise, and the product or service to be
provided;
(b) The market potential for the product or service;
(c) The legal and beneficial shareholding and the names and addresses
of all legal and beneficial shareholders of the enterprise together
with details of directors and management personnel;
(d) The source and form of financing of the enterprise;
(e) The locality of the enterprise and the title to the site held or expected
to be obtained;
(f) The number of persons to be employed and in particular details of
expatriate personnel and the provision for the training of local
persons;
(g) The nature and source of raw materials intended to be used;
(h) Details of proposed capital expenditure;
(i) The dates on which the enterprise will commence its establishment
and on which the enterprise will commence business in Niue;
(j) The type and extent of the incentives, concessions or benefits sought;
736 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(k) The benefits that will accrue to Niue if the application is granted; (l) Such other information as Cabinet may require.
(3) Cabinet shall consider the application having regard to the Investment
Code and may –
(a) Approve the application on such terms and conditions (if any) as
Cabinet may specify; or
(b) Decline the application.
(4) Where an enterprise is granted incentives or concessions pursuant to
subsection (3), such incentives or concessions and any terms or conditions shall
be notified in writing to the enterprise.

18 Registration of foreign enterprise

Approval of an application by a foreign enterprise under section 17 shall
not waive the requirement for that enterprise to be registered pursuant to Part 2
as a foreign enterprise.

19 Government departments or agencies to be informed

Cabinet shall cause such departments or agencies of Government as shall
have an interest in the matter to be notified of every decision made by it under
Part 2 and under this Part, and in particular –
(a) The incentives and concessions (including any terms and conditions
relating thereto) which have been granted, where the administration
of such incentives and concessions ordinarily falls within the
jurisdiction of that department or agency; and
(b) The assistance Cabinet requires of the department or agency in order
to facilitate the establishment by the enterprise of any activity.

20 Variation, suspension and revocation of concessions

(1) Where Cabinet is of the opinion that a foreign enterprise has
contravened or failed to comply with any term or condition of the granting to it of
any incentive concession or benefit, and Cabinet, after due enquiry and having
regard to the nature of the contravention or failure considers that it is undesirable
that the enterprise or any activity carried on by it should continue to receive any
incentive concession or benefit, Cabinet shall notify the enterprise of its opinion
and of the reasons for such opinion, and shall invite the enterprise to make
representations within a period specified by Cabinet, being in any event not less
than 21 days, as to why the grant to the enterprise of any incentive concession or
benefit should not be revoked.
(2) On receipt of any representations made under subsection (1), and after
due consideration of those representations or, upon the expiry of the specified
period if no such representations are made, Cabinet may revoke the grant to the
enterprise of any incentive concession or benefit.
(3) Where Cabinet revokes any grant to the enterprise under subsection
(2), Cabinet shall give notice in writing to the enterprise of its decision and of the
reasons for such decision.

Development Investment Act 1992

737
PART 5
DISCLOSURE AND FILING OF INFORMATION

21 Disclosure and filing

(1) Every enterprise registered as a foreign enterprise under Part 2, and
every enterprise in receipt of a concession, incentive or benefit granted under Part
4 shall, during the currency of such registration concession or benefit, file with
Cabinet (or such department or agency as Cabinet may direct), not later than 30
June in each year –
(a) The name of the enterprise;
(b) The address of the registered office and principal place of business
of the enterprise;
(c) The activities of the enterprise;
(d) The names and addresses of its directors, chief executive officer,
secretary, accountant and auditor or the persons carrying out these
functions;
(e) Details of its shareholder as at the date of filing together with
changes in it since the last date of filing with respect to –
(i) authorised, issued and paid-up shares; and
(ii) shareholders showing the number, class, nominal and paid-up
shares held by each shareholder or on behalf of a beneficiary:
Provided that where the enterprise has not divided its capital into shares, the
information shall relate to any beneficial interest in the capital and profits of the
enterprise held by or on behalf of a person or beneficial owner;
(f) The activities being carried on in Niue by the enterprise.
PART 6
GUARANTEES TO FOREIGN ENTERPRISES

22 Guarantees to foreign enterprises

There is hereby extended to every foreign enterprise registered under this
Act, the following guarantees –
(a) There shall be no compulsory acquisition or expropriation of the
property of any enterprise in Niue except –
(i) in accordance with due process of law; and
(ii) for a public purpose defined by law; and
(iii) for payment of compensation in a manner prescribed by law;
(b) Subject to any law of Niue, every foreign enterprise shall be
entitled –
(i) to remit overseas, earnings and expatriate capital;
(ii) to remit amounts necessary to meet payment principal, interest
and service charges, and similar liabilities on foreign loans and
the cost of other foreign obligations;
(iii) to remit overseas, compensation received in accordance with
paragraph (a)(iii).

23 Application for review

PART 7
JUDICIAL REVIEW
(1) The High Court may, on application (which may be called an application for review) being made to it by an enterprise within 21 days of that enterprise receiving notice of a decision to –
(a) Revoke the registration of the enterprise as a foreign enterprise under section 11(3); or
738 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) Revoke the grant to the enterprise of any incentive, concession or benefit under section 20(2),
by order, grant in relation to such revocation, any relief that the applicant would be entitled to in any one or more of the proceedings for a writ or order of or in the nature of mandamus, prohibition, or certiorari, or for a declaration.
(2) Where on an application for review the applicant is entitled to an order
declaring that a decision made is unauthorised or otherwise invalid, the Court
may, instead of making such a declaration, set aside the decision.
(3) Where in any of the proceedings referred to in subsection (1), the Court
had before the commencement of this Act, a discretion, on like grounds, to refuse
to grant any relief on an application for review, it shall have the like discretion, on
like grounds, to refuse to grant any relief on an application for review.
(4) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing provisions of this
section, on an application for review the Court may direct that the whole or any
part of the subject-matter of an application be reconsidered and redetermined,
either generally or in respect of any specified matter. In giving any such direction
the Court shall –
(a) Advise its reasons for so doing; and
(b) Give such directions as it thinks just as to the reconsideration or
otherwise of the whole or any part of the matter that is referred
back for reconsideration.
(5) Upon the reconsideration of any matter under subsection (4), regard
shall be had to the Court’s reasons for giving the direction and to the Court’s
directions.

24 Defects in form

On an application for review, where the sole ground of relief established is
a defect in form or a technical irregularity, if the Court finds that no substantial
wrong or miscarriage of justice has occurred, it may refuse relief and, where a
decision has already been made, may make an order validating the decision,
notwithstanding the defect or irregularity, to have effect from such time and on
such terms as the Court thinks fit.

25 Interim orders

On an application for review, the Court may make such interim orders as it
thinks proper, pending the final determination of the application.

26 Sufficiency of application

In an application for review it is sufficient if the applicant sets out in the
application the grounds on which relief is sought, and the nature of the relief
sought, without specifying the proceedings referred to in section 23(1) in which
the claim would have been made before the commencement of this Act.

27 Procedure

Subject to this Part, the procedure in respect of any application for review
shall be in accordance with the rules of the High Court.

29 Savings

Nothing in this Part shall limit the Crown Proceedings Act 1950.

Development Investment Act 1992

739

29 Advisory committees

PART 8
MISCELLANEOUS
(1) Cabinet may for the purpose of this Act appoint advisory committees, and may define the functions of any such committee.
(2) The members of an advisory committee appointed under subsection
(1) shall hold office during the pleasure of Cabinet.
(3) There may be paid out of money appropriated by the Assembly for the
purpose to a member of any advisory committee who is not a public servant or
other employee of the Crown, such remuneration and allowance as may be
prescribed by Cabinet.

30 Disclosure

Every member of Cabinet and every other person engaged or employed
by the Crown in connection with the purposes of this Act shall maintain and aid
in maintaining the secrecy of all matters which come to this knowledge when
carrying out any function or duty under this Act, and shall not use to his benefit
or communicate any such matter to any other person, except for the purpose of
carrying out a lawful function under this Act.

31 Personal liability

Every member of Cabinet and every other person engaged or employed
by the Crown in connection with the purposes of this Act shall be exempt from
personal liability in respect of any act or default done or made in connection with
the purposes of this Act in good faith.

32 Service of notices

For the purposes of this Act, any notice to be given by Cabinet shall be
deemed to have been served if delivered to the last known place of business of the
enterprise, or to the last known place of business or residence of any person who
is an officer or shareholder of the enterprise.

33 Offences

(1) A foreign enterprise which carries on business in contravention of
section 8, commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 100 penalty units and, where the offence is a continuing one, to a further
fine not exceeding 5 penalty units for every day or part of a day during which the
offence continues.
(2) Every enterprise which for the purpose of obtaining or retaining any
incentive concession or advantage under this Act, or for the purpose of obtaining
registration of the enterprise or any activity under this Act, makes a false or
misleading statement in any material particular or supplies any false or misleading
information in any material particular commits an offence and shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.
(3) Every enterprise which without lawful excuse refuses or fails to comply
with any provision of section 21 commits an offence and shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 20 penalty units.
(4) Every person who without lawful excuse acts in contravention of section
30, commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50
penalty units or to imprisonment for a term of 12 months or to both.
740 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

34 Offences by corporations

Where a body corporate is guilty of an offence under this Act, and that
offence is proved to have been committed with the consent or connivance of, or to
be attributable to any neglect on the part of any director, manager, secretary or
other officer of the body corporate, or any person purporting to act in any such
capacity, that person as well as the body corporate shall be guilty of that offence
and shall be liable to be proceeded against and punished accordingly.

35 Refund of concessions

Where any enterprise is convicted of any offence under section 33(2), the
enterprise shall, in addition to any other penalty provided by this Act be liable to
refund to the Crown the value of any incentive concession or advantage obtained
by that enterprise at any time under this Act, and the amount so determined shall
be recoverable as a debt due to the Crown.

36 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make all such regulations as may be necessary or expedient
to giving full effect to the purposes or provisions of this Act and for its due
administration.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), Cabinet may make
regulations prescribing –
(a) Fees in respect of applications made under this Act;
(b) Application forms and certificates required for the purpose of this
Act;
(c) Forms of notices required to be given under this Act.

37-38 [Spent]

––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
Section 16
A schedule of incentives and concessions to encourage the establishment of enterprises and development investment.

1 Tariff protection

Import duty may be increased by an amount on a class of commodity
presently or proposed to be produced or supplied by an enterprise to protect an
approved activity where –
(i) the activity is import substituting; and
(ii) the protection is essential for the initial survival of the approved
activity; or
(iii) there is a threat of excessive or unreasonable trade competition
by a foreign exporter into Niue of such a commodity.

2 Import duty concessions

(a) Capital items
Partial or full exemption from import duty may be granted to an
enterprise on the importation, or refund of duty granted to an
enterprise on plant, equipment, machinery or construction materials
used or to be used in an approved activity, provided –

Development Investment Act 1992

741
(i) where the establishment of a project extends over several years, the concession or exemption shall not extend for more than 2 years;
(ii) in the case of an existing or established enterprise, the replacement of capital items due to normal wear and tear or other causes together with consumable stocks shall not qualify for exemption from duty;
(b) Raw materials
Partial or full exemption from import duty may be granted to an
enterprise in respect of any essential raw or processed materials
used directly in any production or manufacturing process in an
approved activity which is import substituting or export generating
for any specified period of time not exceeding 5 years. Cabinet may
extend such concession for up to 2 further periods not exceeding 5
years each.

3 Tax incentives

(a) Tax concessions
Where any new or existing enterprise establishes a new activity in
Niue, or where an activity already existing in Niue is materially
expanded by any new or existing enterprise, and Cabinet is satisfied
that such establishment or expansion will contribute substantially
to the economic development of Niue, Cabinet may grant to that
enterprise such concessions in respect of taxation on the income
derived from that activity as Cabinet thinks fit.
A concession granted by Cabinet may take the form of a partial or
full tax concession and may be granted for any period not exceeding
5 years to an enterprise engaged in an approved activity and may
in special circumstances be renewed or extended up to 2 further
periods of 5 years each.
(b) Recruitment of skilled local persons domiciled overseas
(1) 200 percent of the allowable expenditures and costs on the
recruitment of an employee who is a local person ordinarily
domiciled overseas may be granted to any enterprise as a deduction
against the taxable income of the enterprise in the year it is incurred,
provided the enterprise satisfies Cabinet that –
(i) the person possesses the skill and expertise for the job or
position designated; and
(ii) the person will be employed by the enterprise; and
(iii) the person intends to reside permanently in Niue.
(2) The allowable expenditures and costs in each instance shall
include –
(i) one-way fares for the person, spouse and any children under
15 years of age;
(ii) the cost of freight (to a maximum of $5000) of personal effects;
(iii) local establishment and relocation costs of up to $5000.
(c) Counterpart training
(1) Where an enterprise employing an employee other than a local
person, or an expatriate designates a local person to be trained to
replace the expatriate employee in that position or job, up to 200
percent of the direct cost of training incurred during each year may
be claimed against the taxable income of the enterprise over the
742 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
first 3 years of training.
(2) The allowance training costs shall include –
(i) In the case of overseas training – tuition fees, costs of materials
directly associated with the course, fares of the trainee, salary
or bursary paid to the trainee during the period of training,
provided however that the enterprise first satisfies Cabinet that
the training cannot be adequately carried out in Niue; or
(ii) In the case of local training – tuition fees, costs of materials
directly associated with the course, and where on-the-job
training is provided by an expatriate, the portion of the salary
of the expatriate directly related to the on-the-job training;
(d) Depreciation allowances
Accelerated depreciation allowances up to 200 percent of the rate
specified in the Income Tax Act 1961 may be granted on plant,
machinery, equipment, and permanent buildings used or to be used
in any approved activity.

5 Residence permits

Subject to such conditions normally applying, residence and work permits
may be granted for periods up to 3 years to key personnel or employees of an
approved enterprise.

6 Salary subsidy

Cabinet may approve in certain circumstances and subject to the policies
of Government that a proportion of the wages of a local person be subsidised by
the Government for a period of up to 3 years, such subsidy not to exceed 75 percent
for the first year; 50 percent for the second year and 25 percent for the third and
final year.
743

DIPLOMATIC PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES ACT 1968

1968/36 (NZ) – 1 January 1969

13-18 [Repealed]

PART 4

PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES OF INTERNATIONAL ORGANISATIONS AND PERSONS CONNECTED THEREWITH

8 [Repealed]

9 Privileges, immunities, and capacities of

certain international organisations

9A Privileges, immunities and capacities of

the Commonwealth Secretariat

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

19 Power to grant exemptions

20 General provisions as to exemptions

21 [Repealed]

22 Certificate of Cabinet

23 [Repealed]

24 Regulations

25-27 [Repealed]

SCHEDULES

To consolidate and amend the law relating to diplomatic privileges and immunities, and to give effect to the Vienna Convention on Diplomatic Relations

1 Short title

This is the Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968.

2 [Repealed by 2004/270]

3 Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 1
DIPLOMATIC PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES
(a) “Convention” means the Vienna Convention on Diplomatic Relations signed in 1961, a copy of the English text of which is set out in Schedule 1;
“mission” means a diplomatic mission of any State.
(b) Expressions defined in article 1 of the Convention have the
meanings so defined.
744 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

4 Application of this Part

This Part shall, with respect to the matters dealt with there have effect in
substitution for any previous enactment or rule of law in force in Niue immediately
before the commencement of this Act.

5 Diplomatic privileges and immunities

(1) Subject to subsection (6), articles 1, 22 to 24, and 27 to 40 of the
Convention shall have the force of law in Niue.
(2) Without prejudice to subsection (1), Cabinet may determine, either
generally or in any case or class of case, the fiscal privileges which shall be accorded
to any mission or persons connected with any mission, notwithstanding that the
determination may extend treatment more favourable than that required by the
provisions of the Convention, and may in like manner determine the terms and
conditions on which those privileges may be enjoyed.
(3) (a) For the purpose of giving effect to the custom or agreement by which
Niue and any other State extend to each other treatment more
favourable than is required by the Convention, Cabinet may, by
regulation, declare that a mission of that State and persons
connected with that mission shall be accorded such immunity from
jurisdiction, and inviolability, as are specified in the order;
(b) Nothing in this paragraph shall apply with respect to persons to
whom section 6 applies.
(4) In subsections (2) and (3) “treatment more favourable” includes the
according of privileges or immunities to persons who under the Convention may
enjoy privileges and immunities only to the extent admitted by the receiving State.
(5) Where by or by virtue of this Act immunity from jurisdiction is accorded
to persons who are not diplomatic agents or persons enjoying immunity under
article 37 of the Convention, the immunity accorded to those first-mentioned
persons may be waived in the manner and subject to the conditions specified in
article 32 of the Convention, and the waiver shall have the same consequences as
a waiver under that article.
(6) For the purposes of the articles referred to in subsection (1) –
(a) A reference in those provisions to the receiving State shall be
construed as a reference to Niue;
(b) A reference in those provisions to a national of the receiving State
shall be construed as a reference to a New Zealand citizen;
(c) The reference in article 22(1) to agents of the receiving State shall
be construed as including a reference to any constable and any
person exercising a power of entry to premises;
(d) The reference in article 32 to waiver by the sending State shall be
construed as including a waiver by the head of the mission of the
sending State or by a person for the time being performing the
functions of the head of mission;
(e) Articles 35, 36 and 40 shall be construed as granting the privileges
or immunities that those articles require to be granted;
(f) (i) the reference in article 36(1) to such laws and regulations as
the receiving State may adopt shall be construed as including
a reference to any law in force in Niue relating to the quarantine,
or the prohibition or restriction of the importation into, or the
exportation from, Niue of animals, plants, or goods;
(ii) any immunity from jurisdiction that a person may possess or
enjoy by virtue of subsection (1) shall not be prejudice;

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

745
(g) The reference in article 37(4) to the extent to which privileges and immunities are admitted by the receiving State, and the reference in article 38(1) to any additional privileges and immunities that may be granted by the receiving State, shall, so far as they relate to privileges, be construed as references to such determinations as may be made by the Cabinet under subsection (2) of this section, and, so far as they relate to immunities, be construed as references to such immunities as may be conferred by a Regulation under subsection (3) of this section;
(h) The reference in article 38(2) to the extent to which privileges and immunities are admitted by the receiving State shall, so far as it relates to privileges, be construed as a reference to such determinations as may be made by Cabinet under subsection (2) of this section, and, so far as it relates to immunities, be construed, in relation to persons to whom section 6 applies, as a reference to immunities conferred by that section, and, in relation to other persons to whom that paragraph applies, as a reference to such immunities as may be conferred by regulations under subsection (3) of this section.

6 Immunities of staff of a mission

The members of the administrative and technical staff, and members of the
service staff, of a mission who are New Zealand citizens or are permanently resident
in Niue shall be accorded immunity from jurisdiction, and inviolability, in respect
of official acts performed in the exercise of their functions.

7 Withdrawal of privileges

Where Cabinet is satisfied that the privileges and immunities accorded in relation
to a mission of Niue in any State, or to persons connected with that mission, are
less than those conferred by or by virtue of this Part in relation to the mission of
that State, or to persons connected with that mission, it may, by regulation,
withdraw, modify, or restrict, in relation to that mission or to persons connected
with that mission, such of the privileges and immunities so conferred to such
extent as appears to be proper.
PART 2
PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES OF INTERNATIONAL ORGANISATIONS AND PERSONS CONNECTED
THEREWITH

8 [Repealed by 2004/270]

9 Privileges, immunities, and capacities of certain international organisations

(1) This section shall apply to any organisation declared by Cabinet by regulation to be an organisation of which 2 or more States or the Governments thereof are members.
(2) Cabinet may, by regulation –
(a) Provide that any organisation to which this section applies
(hereinafter referred to as the organisation) shall, to such extent as
may be specified in the order, have the privileges and immunities
specified in Schedule 2 and shall also have the legal capacities of a
body corporate;
746 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
(b) Confer upon –
(i) any persons who are representatives (whether of Governments
or not) on any organ of the organisation or at any conference
convened by the organisation or are members of any committee
of the organisation or of any organ thereof;
(ii) such officers or classes of officers of the organisation as are
specified in the order, being the holders of such high offices in
the organisation as are so specified;
(iii) such persons employed on missions on behalf of the
organisation as are specified in the order – to such extent as
may be specified in the order, the privileges and immunities
specified in Schedule 3;
(c) Confer upon such other classes of officers and servants of the
organisation as are specified in the order, to such extent as may be
so specified, the privileges and immunities specified in Schedule
4 –
and Schedule 5 shall have effect for the purpose of extending to the staffs of such
representatives and members as are mentioned in paragraph (b)(i) and to the
members of the families forming part of the household of officers of the
organisation any privileges and immunities conferred on the representatives,
members, or officers under that paragraph, except in so far as the operation of
Schedule 5 is excluded by the order conferring the privileges and immunities.
(3) No regulation under this section shall confer any privilege or immunity
upon any representative of the Government of Niue or any member of the staff of
such a representative.

9A Privileges, immunities, and capacities of the Commonwealth Secretariat

(1) Cabinet may by regulation –
(a) Provide that the Commonwealth Secretariat shall, to such extent as
may be specified in the regulation, have the privileges and
immunities specified in Schedule 2 and shall also have the legal
capacities of a body corporate;
(b) Confer upon –
(i) any persons who are representatives (whether of Governments
or not) on any organ of the Commonwealth Secretariat or at
any conference convened by the Commonwealth Secretariat,
or are members of any committee of the Commonwealth
Secretariat or of any organ thereof;
(ii) such officers or classes of officers of the Commonwealth
Secretariat as are specified in the order, being the holders of
such high offices in the Commonwealth Secretariat as are so
specified;
(iii) such persons employed on missions on behalf of the
Commonwealth Secretariat as are specified in the order –
to such extent as may be specified in the regulation, the
privileges and immunities specified in Schedule 3;
(c) Confer upon such other classes of officers and servants of the
Commonwealth Secretariat as are specified in the regulation, to such
extent as may be so specified, the privileges and immunities
specified in Schedule 4 –
and Schedule 5 shall have effect for the purpose of extending to the staffs or such
representatives and members as are mentioned in paragraph (b) (i) and to the

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

747
members of the families forming part of the household of officers of the Commonwealth Secretariat any privileges and immunities conferred on the representatives, members, or officers under that paragraph, except in so far as the operation of Schedule 5 is excluded by the regulation conferring the privileges and immunities.
(1A) No regulation under this section shall confer any privilege or
immunity upon any representative of the Government of Niue or any member of
the staff of such a representative.
(2) Schedules 2, 4 and 5 shall apply with respect to the Commonwealth
Secretariat and to persons connected therewith as if every reference in those
Schedules to an organisation included a reference to the Secretariat.

10 The International Court of Justice

Cabinet may, by regulation, confer on the Judges and Registrars of the
International Court of Justice established by the Charter of the United Nations,
and on suitors to that Court and their agents, counsel, and advocates, such
privileges, immunities and facilities as may be required to give effect to any
resolution of, or convention approved by, the General Assembly of the United
Nations.

11 International conferences

Where –
(a) A conference is held in Niue and is attended by representatives of
the Government of Niue and the Government or Governments of
one or more States or of any of the territories for whose international
relations any of those Governments is responsible; and
(b) It appears to Cabinet that doubts may arise as to the extent to which
the representatives of those Governments (other than the
Government of Niue) and members of their official staffs are entitled
to privileges and immunities –
Cabinet may, by notice in the Gazette, direct that every representative of any such
Government (other than the Government of Niue) shall be accorded such of the
privileges and immunities conferred by or by virtue of Part 1 on a diplomatic
agent as Cabinet specifies, and that such of the members of his official staff as the
Cabinet may direct shall be accorded such of the privileges and immunities
conferred by or by virtue of Part 1 on members of the diplomatic staff or the
administrative and technical staff of a diplomatic mission as Cabinet specifies.

12 Reciprocal treatment

Nothing in this Part shall be construed as precluding Cabinet, by regulation,
from declining to accord privileges or immunities to, or from withdrawing,
modifying, or restricting privileges or immunities in relation to nationals or
representatives of any State, or the Government thereof, on the ground that the
State, or the Government thereof, is failing to accord corresponding privileges or
immunities to Niue representatives.

13-18 [Repealed 1977/14/77]

PART 3
748 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1
PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

19 Power to grant exemptions

(1) Notwithstanding any Act, the Minister may wholly or partly exempt
from any public or local tax, duty, rate, levy, or fee any of the following
Governments or persons –
(a) The Government of any State (as defined in section 8) or the
Government of any territory for whose international relations the
Government of any such State is responsible;
(b) A representative or officer of the Government of any country other
than Niue, or of any provisional Government, national committee,
or other authority recognised by Her Majesty in right of Niue, if he
is temporarily resident in Niue under any arrangement made with
the Government of Niue;
(c) A member of the official or domestic staff, or of the family, of any
person to whom paragraph (b) applies.
(2) Where a person who is a member of the official or domestic staff of a
person to whom subsection (1)(b) applies is a New Zealand citizen and not a citizen
of the country concerned, or is not resident in Niue solely for the purpose of
performing his duties as such a member, that person shall not, and a member of
the family of that person shall not by reason only of his being a member of that
family, be entitled to any exemption granted under subsection (1).
(3) In this section, “member of the family”, in relation to any person, means
the spouse or any dependent child of that person.

20 General provisions as to exemptions

(1) The powers conferred on Cabinet by section 9 or section 9A or section
10 or on the Minister by section 19 shall be deemed to include power to exempt
from any fee or duty under any other Act any instrument or class of instruments
to which any organisation, Government, or person, as the case may be, to which
or to whom the order or exemption applies is a party.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) Any exemption granted by Cabinet under section 19 may be granted
either unconditionally or subject to such conditions as Cabinet thinks fit, and
Cabinet may revoke any such exemption or revoke, vary, or add to any such
conditions.
(4) Every exemption referred to in subsection (3) shall come into force on
such date as may be specified in that behalf by Cabinet. The date so specified may
be before or after the date of the granting of the exemption.
(5) Notwithstanding the provisions of any exemption referred to in
subsection (3) any question arising as to the nature or extent of any such exemption,
or to the Governments or persons entitled to any such exemption, shall be referred
to and be determined by Cabinet. The decision of Cabinet shall not be liable to be
challenged, reviewed, quashed, or called in question in any court.
organisation or the Commonwealth Secretariat is or was at any time or in respect of any period accorded any privilege or immunity under or by virtue of this Act, a certificate issued by Cabinet stating any fact relevant to that question shall be conclusive evidence of that fact.

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

749

23

[Repealed by 2004/270]

24

Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as it thinks fit for the purposes of this

Act.

25-27

[Repealed by 2004/270]

SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE 1

Section 3

THE VIENNA CONVENTION ON DIPLOMATIC RELATIONS THE STATES PARTIES TO THE PRESENT CONVENTION,

RECALLING that peoples of all nations from ancient times have recognized the status of

diplomatic agents,

HAVING IN MIND the purposes and principles of the Charter of the United Nations

concerning the sovereign equality of States, the maintenance of international peace and

security, and the promotion of friendly relations among nations,

BELIEVING that an international convention on diplomatic intercourse, privileges and

immunities would contribute to the development of friendly relations among nations,

irrespective of their differing constitutional and social systems,

REALISING that the purpose of such privileges and immunities is not to benefit

individuals but to ensure the efficient performance of the functions of diplomatic missions

as representing States,

AFFIRMING that the rules of customary international law should continue to govern

questions not expressly regulated by the provisions of the present Convention,

HAVE AGREED as follows:

ARTICLE 1

For the purpose of the present Convention, the following expressions shall have the

meanings hereunder assigned to them:

(a) the “head of the mission” is the person charged by the sending State with

the duty of acting in that capacity;

(b) the “members of the mission” are the head of the mission and the members

of the staff of the mission;

(c) the “members of the staff of the mission” are the members of the

diplomatic staff, of the administrative and technical staff and of the service

staff of the mission;

(d) the “members of the diplomatic staff” are the members of the staff of the

mission having diplomatic rank;

(e) a “diplomatic agent” is the head of the mission or a member of the

diplomatic staff of the mission;

(f) the “members of the administrative and technical staff” are the members

of the staff of the mission employed in the administrative and technical

service of the mission;

(g) the “members of the service staff” are the members of the staff of the

mission in the domestic service of the mission;

(h) a “private servant” is a person who is in the domestic service of a member

of the mission and who is not an employee of the sending State;

(i) the “premises of the mission” are the buildings or parts of buildings and

the land ancillary thereto, irrespective of ownership, used for the purposes

of the mission including the residence of the head of the mission.

750 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

ARTICLE 2

The establishment of diplomatic relations between States, and of permanent diplomatic

missions, takes place by mutual consent.

ARTICLE 3

1. The functions of a diplomatic mission consist inter alia in:

(a) representing the sending State in the receiving State;

(b) protecting in the receiving State the interests of the sending State and of

its nationals, within the limits permitted by international law;

(c) negotiating with the Government of the receiving State;

(d) ascertaining by all lawful means conditions and developments in the

receiving State, and reporting thereon to the Government of the sending

State;

(e) promoting friendly relations between the sending State and the receiving

State, and developing their economic, cultural and scientific relations.

2. Nothing in the present Convention shall be construed as preventing the performance of consular functions by a diplomatic mission.

ARTICLE 4

1. The sending State must make certain that the agreement of the receiving State

has been given for the person it proposes to accredit as head of the mission to that State.

2. The receiving State is not obliged to give reasons to the sending State for a

refusal of agrément.

ARTICLE 5

1. The sending State may, after it has given due notification to the receiving

States concerned, accredit a head of mission or assign any member of the diplomatic

staff, as the case may be, to more than one State, unless there is express objection by any

of the receiving States.

2. If the sending State accredits a head of mission to one or more other States it

may establish a diplomatic mission headed by a charge d’affaires ad interim in each State

where the head of mission has not his permanent seat.

3. A head of mission or any member of the diplomatic staff of the mission may

act as representative of the sending State to any international organisation.

ARTICLE 6

Two or more States may accredit the same person as head of mission to another State,

unless objection is offered by the receiving State.

ARTICLE 7

Subject to the provisions of Articles 5, 8, 9 and 11, the sending State may freely appoint

the members of the staff of the mission. In the case of military, naval or air attaches, the

receiving State may require their names to be submitted beforehand, for its approval.

ARTICLE 8

1. Members of the diplomatic staff of the mission should in principle be of the

nationality of the sending State.

2. Members of the diplomatic staff of the mission may not be appointed from

among persons having the nationality of the receiving State, except with the consent of

that State which may be withdrawn at any time.

3. The receiving State may reserve the same right with regard to nationals of a

third State who are not also nationals of the sending State.

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

751

ARTICLE 9

1. The receiving State may at any time and without having to explain its decision,

notify the sending State that the head of the mission or any member of the diplomatic

staff of the mission is persona non grata or that any other member of the staff of the mission

is not acceptable. In any such case, the sending State shall, as appropriate, either recall

the person concerned or terminate his functions with the mission. A person may be

declared non grata or not acceptable before arriving in the territory of the receiving State.

2. If the sending State refuses or fails within a reasonable period to carry out its

obligations under paragraph 1 of this Article, the receiving State may refuse to recognise

the person concerned as a member of the mission.

ARTICLE 10

1. The Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the receiving State, or such other ministry

as may be agreed, shall be notified of:

(a) the appointment of members of the mission, their arrival and their final

departure or the termination of their functions with the mission;

(b) the arrival and final departure of a person belonging to the family of a

member of the mission and, where appropriate, the fact that a person

becomes or ceases to be a member of the family of a member of the mission;

(c) the arrival and final departure of private servants in the employ of persons

referred to in sub-paragraph (a) of this paragraph and, where appropriate,

the fact that they are leaving the employ of such persons;

(d) the engagement and discharge of persons resident in the receiving State

as members of the mission or private servants entitled to privileges and

immunities.

2. Where possible, prior notification of arrival and final departure shall also be

given.

ARTICLE 11

1. In the absence of specific agreement as to the size of the mission, the receiving

State may require that the size of a mission be kept within limits considered by it to be

reasonable and normal, having regard to circumstances and conditions in the receiving

State and to the needs of the particular mission.

2. The receiving State may equally, within similar bounds and on a non­

discriminatory basis, refuse to accept officials of a particular category.

ARTICLE 12

The sending State may not, without the prior express consent of the receiving State,

establish offices forming part of the mission in localities other than those in which the

mission itself is established.

ARTICLE 13

1. The head of the mission is considered as having taken up his functions in the

receiving State either when he has presented his credentials or when he has notified his

arrival and a true copy of his credentials has been presented to the Ministry for Foreign

Affairs of the receiving State, or such other ministry as may be agreed, in accordance with

the practice prevailing in the receiving State which shall be applied in a uniform manner.

2. The order of presentation of credentials or of a true copy thereof will be

determined by the date and time of the arrival of the head of the mission.

ARTICLE 14

1. Heads of mission are divided into 3 classes, namely:

(a) that of ambassadors or nuncios accredited to Heads of State, and other

heads of mission of equivalent rank;

(b) that of envoys, ministers and internuncios accredited to Heads of State;

(c) that of chargés d’affaires accredited to Ministers for Foreign Affairs.

752 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

2. Except as concerns precedence and etiquette, there shall be no differentiation between heads of mission by reason of their class.

ARTICLE 15

The class to which the heads of their missions are to be assigned shall be agreed between

States.

ARTICLE 16

1. Heads of mission shall take precedence in their respective classes in the order

of the date and time of taking up their functions in accordance with Article 13.

2. Alterations in the credentials of a head of mission not involving any change

of class shall not affect his precedence.

3. This article is without prejudice to any practice accepted by the receiving

State regarding the precedence of the representative of the Holy See.

ARTICLE 17

The precedence of the members of the diplomatic staff of the mission shall be notified by

the head of the mission to the Ministry for Foreign Affairs or such other ministry as may

be agreed.

ARTICLE 18

The procedure to be observed in each State for the reception of heads of mission shall be

uniform in respect of each class.

ARTICLE 19

1. If the post of head of the mission is vacant, or if the head of the mission is

unable to perform his functions, a chargé d’affaires ad interim shall act provisionally as

head of the mission. The name of the chargé d’affaires ad interim shall be notified, either by

the head of the mission or, in case he is unable to do so, by the Ministry for Foreign

Affairs of the sending State to the Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the receiving State or

such other ministry as may be agreed.

2. In cases where no member of the diplomatic staff of the mission is present in

the receiving State, a member of the administrative and technical staff may, with the

consent of the receiving State, be designated by the sending State to be in charge of the

current administrative affairs of the mission.

ARTICLE 20

The mission and its head shall have the right to use the flag and emblem of the sending

State on the premises of the mission, including the residence of the head of the mission,

and on his means of transport.

ARTICLE 21

1. The receiving State shall either facilitate the acquisition on its territory, in

accordance with its laws, by the sending State of premises necessary for its mission or

assist the latter in obtaining accommodation in some other way.

2. It shall also, where necessary, assist missions in obtaining suitable

accommodation for their members.

ARTICLE 22

1. The premises of the mission shall be inviolable. The agents of the receiving

State may not enter them, except with the consent of the head of the mission.

2. The receiving State is under a special duty to take all appropriate steps to

protect the premises of the mission against any intrusion or damage and to prevent any

disturbance of the peace of the mission or impairment of its dignity.

3. The premises of the mission, their furnishings and other property thereon

and the means of transport of the mission shall be immune from search, requisition,

attachment or execution.

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

753

ARTICLE 23

1. The sending State and the head of the mission shall be exempt from all national,

regional or municipal dues and taxes in respect of the premises of the mission, whether

owned or leased, other than such as represent payment for specific services rendered.

2. The exemption from taxation referred to in this Article shall not apply to such

dues and taxes payable under the law of the receiving State by persons contracting with

the sending State or the head of the mission.

ARTICLE 24

The archives and documents of the mission shall be inviolable at any time and wherever

they may be.

ARTICLE 25

The receiving State shall accord full facilities for the performance of the functions of the

mission.

ARTICLE 26

Subject to its laws and regulations concerning zones entry into which is prohibited or

regulated for reasons of national security, the receiving State shall ensure to all members

of the mission freedom of movement and travel in its territory.

ARTICLE 27

1. The receiving State shall permit and protect free communication on the part

of the mission for all official purposes. In communicating with the Government and the

other missions and consulates of the sending State, wherever situated, the mission may

employ all appropriate means, including diplomatic couriers and messages in code or

cipher. However, the mission may install and use a wireless transmitter only with the

consent of the receiving State.

2. The official correspondence of the mission shall be inviolable. Official

correspondence means all correspondence relating to the mission and its functions.

3. The diplomatic bag shall not be opened or detained.

4. The packages constituting the diplomatic bag must bear visible external marks

of their character and may contain only diplomatic documents or articles intended for

official use.

5. The diplomatic courier, who shall be provided with an official document

indicating his status and the number of packages constituting the diplomatic bag, shall

be protected by the receiving State in the performance of his functions. He shall enjoy

personal inviolability and shall not be liable to any form of arrest or detention.

6. The sending State or the mission may designate diplomatic couriers ad hoc. In

such cases the provisions of paragraph 5 of this Article shall also apply, except that the

immunities therein mentioned shall cease to apply when such a courier has delivered to

the consignee the diplomatic bag in his charge.

7. A diplomatic bag may be entrusted to the captain of a commercial aircraft

scheduled to land at an authorised port of entry. He shall be provided with an official

document indicating the number of packages constituting the bag but he shall not be

considered to be a diplomatic courier. The mission may send one of its members to take

possession of the diplomatic bag directly and freely from the captain of the aircraft.

ARTICLE 28

The fees and charges levied by the mission in the course of its official duties shall be

exempt from all dues and taxes.

ARTICLE 29

The person of a diplomatic agent shall be inviolable. He shall not be liable to any form of

arrest or detention. The receiving State shall treat him with due respect and shall take all

appropriate steps to prevent any attack on his person, freedom or dignity.

754 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

ARTICLE 30

1. The private residence of a diplomatic agent shall enjoy the same inviolability

and protection as the premises of the mission.

2. His papers, correspondence and, except as provided in paragraph 3 of Article

31, his property, shall likewise enjoy inviolability.

ARTICLE 31

1. A diplomatic agent shall enjoy immunity from the criminal jurisdiction of the

receiving State. He shall also enjoy immunity from its civil and administrative jurisdiction,

except in the case of:

(a) a real action relating to private immovable property situated in the

territory of the receiving State, unless he holds it on behalf of the sending

State for the purposes of the mission;

(b) an action relating to succession in which the diplomatic agent is involved

as executor, administrator, heir or legatee as a private person and not on

behalf of the sending State;

(c) an action relating to any professional or commercial activity exercised by

the diplomatic agent in the receiving State outside his official functions.

2. A diplomatic agent is not obliged to give evidence as a witness.

3. No measures of execution may be taken in respect of a diplomatic agent except

in the cases coming under subparagraphs (a), (b) and (c) of paragraph 1 of this Article,

and provided that the measures concerned can be taken without infringing the inviolability

of his person or of his residence.

4. The immunity of a diplomatic agent from the jurisdiction of the receiving

State does not exempt him from the jurisdiction of the sending State.

ARTICLE 32

1. The immunity from jurisdiction of diplomatic agents and of persons enjoying

immunity under Article 37 may be waived by the sending State.

2. Waiver must always be express.

3. The initiation of proceedings by a diplomatic agent or by a person enjoying

immunity from jurisdiction under Article 37 shall preclude him from invoking immunity

from jurisdiction in respect of any counterclaim directly connected with the principal

claim.

4. Waiver of immunity from jurisdiction in respect of civil or administrative proceedings shall not be held to imply waiver of immunity in respect of the execution of the judgment, for which a separate waiver shall be necessary.

ARTICLE 33

1. Subject to the provisions of paragraph 3 of this Article, a diplomatic agent

shall with respect to services rendered for the sending State be exempt from social security

provisions which may be in force in the receiving State.

2. The exemption provided for in paragraph 1 of this Article shall also apply to

private servants who are in the sole employ of a diplomatic agent, on condition:

(a) that they are not nationals of or permanently resident in the receiving

State; and

(b) that they are covered by the social security provisions which may be in

force in the sending State or a third State.

3. A diplomatic agent who employs persons to whom the exemption provided

for in paragraph 2 of this Article does not apply shall observe the obligations which the

social security provisions of the receiving State impose upon employers.

4. The exemption provided for in paragraphs 1 and 2 of this Article shall not

preclude voluntary participation in the social security system of the receiving State

provided that such participation is permitted by that State.

5. The provisions of this Article shall not affect bilateral or multilateral

agreements concerning social security concluded previously and shall not prevent the

conclusion of such agreements in the future.

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

755

ARTICLE 34

A diplomatic agent shall be exempt from all dues and taxes, personal or real, national,

regional or municipal, except:

(a) indirect taxes of a kind which are normally incorporated in the price of

goods or services;

(b) dues and taxes on private immovable property situated in the territory of

the receiving State, unless he holds it on behalf of the sending State for

the purposes of the mission;

(c) estate, succession or inheritance duties levied by the receiving State,

subject to the provisions of paragraph 4 of the Article 39;

(d) dues and taxes on private income having its source in the receiving State

and capital taxes on investments made in commercial undertakings in

the receiving State;

(e) charges levied for specific services rendered;

(f) registration, court or record fees, mortgage dues and stamp duty, with

respect to immovable property, subject to the provisions of Article 23.

ARTICLE 35

The receiving State shall exempt diplomatic agents from all personal services, from all

public service of any kind whatsoever, and from military obligations such as those

connected with requisitioning, military contributions and billeting.

ARTICLE 36

1. The receiving State shall, in accordance with such laws and regulations as it

may adopt, permit entry of and grant exemption from all customs duties, taxes, and related

charges other than charges for storage, cartage and similar services, on:

(a) articles for the official use of the mission;

(b) articles for the personal use of a diplomatic agent or members of his family

forming part of his household, including articles intended for his

establishment.

2. The personal baggage of a diplomatic agent shall be exempt from inspection,

unless there are serious grounds for presuming that it contains articles not covered by the

exemptions mentioned in paragraph 1 of this Article, or articles the import or export of

which is prohibited by the law or controlled by the quarantine regulations of the receiving

State. Such inspection shall be conducted only in the presence of the diplomatic agent or

of his authorised representative.

ARTICLE 37

1. The members of the family of a diplomatic agent forming part of his household

shall, if they are not nationals of the receiving State, enjoy the privileges and immunities

specified in Articles 29 to 36.

2. Members of the administrative and technical staff of the mission, together

with members of their families forming part of their respective households, shall, if they

are not nationals of or permanently resident in the receiving State, enjoy the privileges

and immunities specified in Articles 29 to 35, except that the immunity from civil and

administrative jurisdiction of the receiving State specified in paragraph 1 of Article 31

shall not extend to acts performed outside the course of their duties. They shall also enjoy

the privileges specified in Article 36, paragraph 1, in respect of articles imported at the

time of first installation.

3. Members of the service staff of the mission who are not nationals of or

permanently resident in the receiving State shall enjoy immunity in respect of acts

performed in the course of their duties, exemption from dues and taxes on the emoluments

they receive by reason of their employment and the exemption contained in Article 33.

4. Private servants of members of the mission shall, if they are not nationals of

or permanently resident in the receiving State, be exempt from dues and taxes on the

emoluments they receive by reason of their employment. In other respects, they may

756 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

enjoy privileges and immunities only to the extent admitted by the receiving State. However, the receiving State must exercise its jurisdiction over those persons in such a manner as not to interfere unduly with the performance of the functions of the mission.

ARTICLE 38

1. Except insofar as additional privileges and immunities may be granted by

the receiving State, a diplomatic agent who is a national of or permanently resident in

that State shall enjoy only immunity from jurisdiction, and inviolability, in respect of

official acts performed in the exercise of his functions.

2. Other members of the staff of the mission and private servants who are

nationals of or permanently resident in the receiving State shall enjoy privileges and

immunities only to the extent admitted by the receiving State. However, the receiving

State must exercise its jurisdiction over those persons in such a manner as not to interfere

unduly with the performance of the functions of the mission.

ARTICLE 39

1. Every person entitled to privileges and immunities shall enjoy them from the

moment he enters the territory of the receiving State on proceeding to take up his post or,

if already in its territory, from the moment when his appointment is notified to the Ministry

for Foreign Affairs or such other ministry as may be agreed.

2. When the functions of a person enjoying privileges and immunities have come

to an end, such privileges and immunities shall normally cease at the moment when he

leaves the country, or on expiry of a reasonable period in which to do so, but shall subsist

until that time, even in case of armed conflict. However, with respect to acts performed

by such a person in the exercise of his functions as a member of the mission, immunity

shall continue to subsist.

3. In case of the death of a member of the mission, the members of his family

shall continue to enjoy the privileges and immunities to which they are entitled until the

expiry of a reasonable period in which to leave the country.

4. In the event of the death of a member of the mission not a national of or

permanently resident in the receiving State or a member of his family forming part of his

household, the receiving State shall permit the withdrawal of the movable property of

the deceased, with the exception of any property acquired in the country the export of

which was prohibited at the time of his death. Estate, succession and inheritance duties

shall not be levied on movable property the presence of which in the receiving State was

due solely to the presence there of the deceased as a member of the mission or as a member

of the family of a member of the mission.

ARTICLE 40

1. If a diplomatic agent passes through or is in the territory of a third State,

which has granted him a passport visa if such visa was necessary, while proceeding to

take up or to return to his post, or when returning to his own country, the third State shall

accord him inviolability and such other immunities as may be required to ensure his

transit or return. The same shall apply in the case of any members of his family enjoying

privileges or immunities who are accompanying the diplomatic agent, or travelling

separately to join him or to return to their country.

2. In circumstances similar to those specified in paragraph 1 of this Article third

States shall not hinder the passage of members of the administrative and technical or

service staff of a mission, and of members of their families, through their territories.

3. Third States shall accord to official correspondence and other official

communications in transit, including messages in code or cipher, the same freedom and

protection as is accorded by the receiving State. They shall accord to diplomatic couriers,

who have been granted a passport visa if such visa was necessary, and diplomatic bags in

transit the same inviolability and protection as the receiving State is bound to accord.

4. The obligations of third States under paragraphs 1, 2 and 3 of this Article

shall also apply to the persons mentioned respectively in those paragraphs, and to official

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

757

communications and diplomatic bags, whose presence in the territory of the third State is due to force majeure.

ARTICLE 41

1. Without prejudice to their privileges and immunities, it is the duty of all

persons enjoying such privileges and immunities to respect the laws and regulations of

the receiving State. They also have a duty not to interfere in the internal affairs of that

State.

2. All official business with the receiving State entrusted to the mission by the sending State shall be conducted with or through the Ministry for Foreign Affairs of the receiving State or such other ministry as may be agreed.

3. The premises of the mission must not be used in any manner incompatible with the functions of the mission as laid down in the present Convention or by other rules of general international law or by any special agreements in force between the sending and the receiving State.

ARTICLE 42

A diplomatic agent shall not in the receiving State practise for personal profit any

professional or commercial activity.

ARTICLE 43

The function of a diplomatic agent comes to an end, inter alia:

(a) on notification by the sending State to the receiving State that the function

of the diplomatic agent has come to an end:

(b) on notification by the receiving State to the sending State that, in

accordance with paragraph 2 of Article 9, it refuses to recognise the

diplomatic agent as a member of the mission.

ARTICLE 44

The receiving State must, even in case of armed conflict, grant facilities in order to enable

persons enjoying privileges and immunities, other than nationals of the receiving State,

and members of the families of such persons irrespective of their nationality, to leave at

the earliest possible moment. It must, in particular, in case of need, place at their disposal

the necessary means of transport for themselves and their property.

ARTICLE 45

If diplomatic relations are broken off between 2 States, or if a mission is permanently or

temporarily recalled:

(a) the receiving State must, even in case of armed conflict, respect and protect

the premises of the mission, together with its property and archives:

(b) the sending State may entrust the custody of the premises of the mission,

together with its property and archives, to a third State acceptable to the

receiving State:

(c) the sending State may entrust the protection of its interests and those of

its nationals to a third State acceptable to the receiving State.

ARTICLE 46

A sending State may with the prior consent of a receiving State, and at the request of a

third State not represented in the receiving State, undertake the temporary protection of

the interests of the third State and of its nationals.

758 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

ARTICLE 47

1. In the application of the provisions of the present Convention, the receiving

State shall not discriminate as between States.

2. However, discrimination shall not be regarded as taking place:

(a) where the receiving State applies any of the provisions of the present

Convention restrictively because of a restrictive application of that

provision to its mission in the sending State:

(b) where by custom or agreement States extend to each other more favourable

treatment than is required by the provisions of the present Convention.

ARTICLE 48

The present Convention shall be open for signature by all States Members of the United

Nations or of any of the specialised agencies or Parties to the Statute of the International

Court of Justice, and by any other State invited by the General Assembly of the United

Nations to become a Party to the Convention, as follows: until 31 October 1961 at the

Federal Ministry for Foreign Affairs of Austria and subsequently, until 31 March 1962, at

the United Nations Headquarters in New York.

ARTICLE 49

The present Convention is subject to ratification. The instruments of ratification shall be

deposited with the Secretary-General of the United Nations.

ARTICLE 50

The present Convention shall remain open for accession by any State belonging to any of

the 4 categories mentioned in Article 48. The instruments of accession shall be deposited

with the Secretary-General of the United Nations.

ARTICLE 51

1. The present Convention shall enter into force on the thirtieth day following

the date of deposit of the twenty-second instrument of ratification or accession with the

Secretary-General of the United Nations.

2. For each State ratifying or acceding to the Convention after the deposit of the

twenty-second instrument of ratification or accession, the Convention shall enter into

force on the thirtieth day after deposit by such State of its instrument of ratification or

accession.

ARTICLE 52

The Secretary-General of the United Nations shall inform all States belonging to any of

the 4 categories mentioned in Article 48:

(a) of signatures to the present Convention and of the deposit of instruments

of ratification or accession, in accordance with Articles 48, 49 and 50:

(b) of the date on which the present Convention will enter into force, in

accordance with Article 51.

ARTICLE 53

The original of the present Convention, of which the Chinese, English, French, Russian

and Spanish texts are equally authentic, shall be deposited with the Secretary-General of

the United Nations, who shall send certified copies thereof to all States belonging to any

of the 4 categories mentioned in Article 48.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF the undersigned Plenipotentiaries, being duly authorised thereto by their respective Governments, have signed the present Convention.

DONE AT VIENNA, this eighteenth day of April one thousand nine hundred and sixty- one.

[Signatures not reproduced.]

Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968

SCHEDULE 2

Section 9(2)(a)

PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES OF INTERNATIONAL ORGANISATIONS

759

1. Immunity from suit and legal process.

2. The like inviolability of official premises and archives as is accorded in respect

of the official premises and archives of a diplomatic mission.

3. Immunity in relation to its property and assets, wherever located and by

whomsoever held, from search, requisition, confiscation, expropriation, or any other form

of interference.

4. The like exemption from taxes and rates, other than taxes on the importation

of goods, as is accorded to the Government of any foreign State.

5. Exemption from taxes on the importation of goods directly imported by the

organisation for its official use in New Zealand or for exportation, or on the importation

of any publications of the organisation directly imported by it, subject to compliance

with such conditions as the Minister of Customs may determine for the protection of the

revenue.

6. Exemption from prohibitions and restrictions on importation or exportation

in the case of goods directly imported or exported by the organisation for its official use

and in the case of any publications of the organisation directly imported or exported by

it, subject to compliance with such conditions as the Minister of Customs may determine

for the protection of the public health, the prevention of diseases in plants and animals,

and otherwise in the public interest.

7. The right to avail itself, for telegraphic communications sent by it and

containing only matter intended for publication by the press or for broadcasting (including

communications addressed to or dispatched from places outside New Zealand), of any

reduced rates applicable for the corresponding service in the case of press telegrams.

SCHEDULE 3

Section 9(2)(b)

PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES OF REPRESENTATIVES, MEMBERS OF COMMITTEES, HIGH OFFICERS, [PERSONS ON MISSIONS, AND CERTAIN MEMBERS OF EC DELEGATIONS]

agent.

1. The like immunity from suit and legal process as is accorded to a diplomatic

2. The like inviolability of residence, official premises, and official archives as is

accorded to a diplomatic agent.

3. The like exemption from taxes and rates as is accorded to a diplomatic agent.

SCHEDULE 4

Section 9(2)(c)

PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES OF OTHER OFFICERS AND SERVANTS, [MEMBERS OF EC DELEGATIONS WHO ARE SERVICE STAFF, AND PRIVATE SERVANTS OF MEMBERS OF EC DELEGATIONS]

1. Immunity from suit and legal process in respect of things done or omitted to be done in the course of the performance of official duties.

2. Exemption from taxes in respect of emoluments received as an officer or servant of the organisation.

760 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 1

3. Exemption from taxes on the importation of furniture and effects imported at the time of first taking up post in New Zealand, that exemption to be subject to compliance with such conditions as the Minister of Customs may determine for the protection of the revenue.

SCHEDULE 5

Section 9(2)

PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES OF OFFICIAL STAFFS AND OF HIGH OFFICERS’ FAMILIES

1. Where any person is accorded any such immunities and privileges as are mentioned in Schedule 3 to this Act as the representative on any organ of the organisation or a member of any committee of the organisation or of an organ thereof, the members of his official staff accompanying him as such a representative or member shall also be accorded those immunities and privileges to the same extent as the members of the staff of a mission are accorded the immunities and privileges accorded to a diplomatic agent.

2. Where any person is accorded any such privileges and immunities as are mentioned in Schedule 3 to this Act as an officer of the organisation, the members of the family of that person who form part of his household shall also be accorded those privileges and immunities to the same extent as the members of the family of a diplomatic agent who form part of his household are accorded the privileges and immunities accorded to that diplomatic agent.

761

DOGS ACT 1966

1966/35 – 1 July 1966

1 Short title

PART 1 18 Imposition of fine not to affect fees

PRELIMINARY 19 Remission and refund of fees

2 [Spent] PART 4

3 Interpretation TOTAL NUMBER OF DOGS ON NIUE SUBJECT TO

CONTROL

PART 2 20-21 [Repealed] THE REGISTRAR

4

Registrar and Registration Office

PART 5

5

Principal duties of Registrar

LIABILITY FOR INJURIES OR DAMAGE CAUSED BY

6

Register

DOGS

22

Dangerous dogs may be destroyed

PART 3

23

Dog attacks

REGISTRATION

24

Proof of mischievous propensity

7

Dogs to be registered

8

Dog collars and registration labels

PART 6

9

Mode of registration

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

10

Effect of registration

25

Protection of officers of police

11

Annual registration

26

No liability where dog wounded

12

Registration fees and other charges

27

No compensation for destruction of dogs

13

Change of ownership

28

Fines not affected by destruction of dog

14

Registration label

29

Destroyed dogs

15

Offences

30

Offences (Generan( �/p>

16

Dogs that may be destroyed

31

-32 [Repealed]

17

Burden of proof

33

Liability of owners of dogs

To provide for the registration and control of dogs and the liability for injuries and damage caused by dogs

1 Short title

This is the Dogs Act 1966.

2 [Spent]

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“owner” (of a dog) includes every person who –
(i) has the dog in his keep, care, custody, charge, or possession for
the time being, whether the dog is at large or in confinement;
or
762 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(ii) occupies any dwelling, business premises or other place in which the dog is usually harboured or permitted to remain; and
“registration label” means the label described in section 8 (1);
“Secretary” means the Financial Secretary appointed under the authority
of the Customs Act 1966;
“vehicle” means any vehicle within the meaning of the Transport Act 1965;
“year” means a period of 12 months commencing on 1 April in each year
and ending with 31 March then next ensuing.
PART 2
THE REGISTRAR

4 Registrar and Registration Office

(1) The duties of the Registrar under this Act shall form part of the duties
of the Chief Officer of Police.
(2) (a) The Chief Officer of Police shall be deemed to be “the Registrar”
within the meaning of this Act;
(b) Any reference in this Act to the Registrar shall be construed to
include reference to every constable performing the duties of
Registrar under this Act on behalf and under the authority of the
Chief Officer of Police.
(3) The office of the Chief Officer of Police shall be deemed to be the office
of the Registrar.

5 Principal duties of Registrar

The principal duties of the Registrar shall be –
(a) To keep at his office a register for the purposes of this Act;
(b) To make in the register the entries required by this Act;
(c) To receive and record all registration fees and any other money
payable at his office under this Act.

6 Register

(1) The pages of the register shall be divided into columns under headings
and indicating the entries required to be made by section 9(2)(b).
(2) The register shall be kept in book form or in any other form approved
by Cabinet.
(3) The register may be examined by any person during office hours free
of charge.

7 Dogs to be registered

PART 3
REGISTRATION
(1) No person shall own any dog of a greater age than 6 months for a period exceeding 14 days unless the dog is for the time being registered under this Act. (2) Every owner of any such dog who does not apply for registration of
that dog on or before the expiration of the period of 14 days commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
(3) It shall be lawful for the owner of any dog to have his dog registered before it attains the age of 6 months and the Registrar shall not refuse registration on the ground that the dog has not attained that age.

Dogs Act 1966

763

8 Dog collars and registration labels

(1) There shall be kept at the office of the Registrar a supply of dog collars
having a metal label securely affixed to each collar numbered consecutively from
number one in each year upwards and marked with the year for which each collar
is issued.
(2) Every owner shall be entitled to receive a collar, as provided in section
9 in respect of each dog which is being registered.
(3) Duplicate collars shall be issued on affirmation that the original has
been lost or stolen.

9 Mode of registration

(1) Application for every registration required under this Act shall be made
by the owner, or by some person on his behalf, delivering or giving at the office of
the Registrar a description of the dog and paying the prescribed registration fee
and other charges (if any) unless remitted under section 19 with his application
for registration.
(2) On receiving every amount so payable the Registrar shall –
(a) Issue a receipt therefore and a collar bearing the then available next
number in consecutive order, to be worn on the neck of the dog;
(b) Register the dog by entering in the register –
(i) the name and residence of the owner;
(ii) the number of the registration label on the collar issued;
(iii) a description of the dog by which the collar is to be worn
including kind or breed, age, sex, colour and other
distinguishing marks or peculiarities (if any);
(iv) such other particulars as Cabinet may determine.
(3) Every person applying for the registration of a dog, who knowingly
inserts or omits, or knowingly causes or permits to be inserted or omitted in the
description of the dog to be registered any matter or thing contrary to or for the
purpose of concealing the truth or who wilfully makes any false or misleading
statement or material omission in any information supplied to the Registrar,
commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5
penalty units.

10 Effect of registration

Every registration when duly made shall be deemed to be in force on the
day on which it is made, and shall continue in force until 31 March then next
ensuing.

11 Annual registration

(1) Every registration shall be again made on or before 15 April of the next
ensuing year if the dog first registered is still alive and kept on Niue at that time
and shall be again so made from year to year.
(2) Every owner who does not apply for registration on or before 15 April
of each year as specified in subsection (1) commits an offence and shall be liable
on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
(3) The provisions of section 8(2), section 9 and section 10 shall apply.
764 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

12 Registration fees and other charges

(1) The fees payable for the registration of dogs under section 7 or section
11 shall be as Cabinet may prescribe by regulation.
(2) The charge for collars and duplicate collars including registration labels
shall be such amount of money as Cabinet by public notice may determine, and as
far as not so determined the charge for a collar as aforesaid shall be deemed to be
included in the registration fee provided in subsection (1) and the charge for
duplicate collars shall be the amount of their cost to the Government.

13 Change of ownership

(1) Where the ownership of a registered dog is changed, the registration of
the dog shall continue in force, but the new owner shall within 14 days notify the
Registrar of the change in ownership, and the Registrar shall, without payment of
any fee, enter the name of the new owner in the register in substitution for the
name of the previous owner.
(2) Every person who fails to notify the Registrar as aforesaid commits an
offence.

14 Registration label

(1) It shall be lawful for the owner of any dog registered under this Act to
affix to any other dog collar (in the manner in which it was affixed to the collar
supplied by the Registrar) the registration label affixed to the collar supplied in
respect of that dog by the Registrar.
(2) Nothing in this section shall be construed to authorise the wearing of
any registration label by any dog other than the dog in respect of which it was
issued.

15 Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence who –
(a) Falsely makes or counterfeits or, knowing the same to be false or
counterfeit, purchases, uses, or has in his possession any label
resembling or apparently intended to resemble or pass for a
registration label;
(b) Is the owner of any dog wearing a registration label issued in respect
of another dog; or
(c) Has his dog duly registered but allows it to be at large not wearing
a collar having the registration label affixed to it;
(d) Wilfully abandons any dog, whether for the purpose of avoiding
registration or not;
(e) Removes (except for the purposes of section 14) the registration
label affixed to the collar to be worn by his dog; or
(f) Removes from the neck of any dog the collar or the registration
label required by his Act to be worn by that dog.
(2) If any dog is destroyed as provided in section 16 in consequence of the
removal of the collar or registration label specified in subsection (1)(f), every person
responsible for such removal may be ordered to pay to the owner the full value of
the dog so destroyed as determined by the court in addition to any fine imposed.

Dogs Act 1966

765

16 Dogs that may be destroyed

(1) Any constable may destroy every dog found at large in any place, if
that dog –
(a) Being a dog apparently over the age of 6 months does not wear a collar having the registration label affixed; or
(b) Being a dog of any age and whether wearing a collar as aforesaid
or not, is apparently suffering from disease or neglect.
(2) Every constable may for the purposes of this section enter any place at
any time.
(3) Any person other than a constable finding a dog apparently over the
age of 6 months at large in any place not being a public place without wearing a
collar having the registration label affixed to it, may, without being answerable to
the owner, destroy the dog if, on reasonable grounds he fears that the dog may
cause damage to his property.

17 Burden of proof

In any proceedings under this Act –
(a) Any dog not wearing a collar having the registration label affixed
to it shall, until the contrary is proved, be deemed to be unregistered;
(b) Any dog wearing after 15 April in any year a collar having affixed
to it the registration label issued for the year preceding the then
current year, shall, until the contrary is proved, be deemed to be
not registered for the then current year as prescribed in section 11;
(c) The proof that a dog has been duly registered or does not require to
be registered, shall be on the defendant.

18 Imposition of fine not to affect fees

The imposition by the Court of any fine for failing to comply with this Act
relating to registration shall not be construed as a release from the payment of any
fee or other charge due.

19 Remission and refund of fees

The Cabinet on grounds of hardship, may cause the whole or any portion
of any fee payable under this Act to be remitted or refunded.
PART 4
TOTAL NUMBER OF DOGS ON NIUE SUBJECT TO CONTROL
LIABILITY FOR INJURIES OR DAMAGE CAUSED BY DOGS

22 Dangerous dogs may be destroyed

Where complaint is made to the Chief Officer of Police or the court that a
dog, whether at large or not, is dangerous and is not kept under proper control, the court, if it is satisfied as to the grounds of the complaint, may, in addition to any fine that may be imposed under this Act, order that the dog be destroyed by the Police.
766 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

23 Dog attacks

(1) Where any dog –
(a) Rushes at, or attacks, bites, startles or worries any person or any
kind of poultry or animal being the property of any person whereby
such person, poultry or animal is killed or injured or endangered
or any other property damaged or endangered; or
(b) Rushes at any vehicle in such a manner as to cause or to be likely to
cause an accident;
the owner of the dog commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine
not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
(2) If it is proved to the satisfaction of the Court that the owner of a dog
which causes an occurrence as aforesaid, permitted that dog to be at large although
the dog was known to him to have been the cause of any such occurrence before,
the owner shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units in lieu of the fine
provided in subsection (1).
(3) Any person affected by the occurrence or witnessing same may, without
being answerable to the owner, forthwith destroy the dog.
(4) Any fine provided in this section may be imposed in addition to any
liability the owner may incur for injury or damage caused by the dog.
(5) In addition to any fine imposed under this section, the court may order
that any dog which has not been destroyed under subsection (3), be destroyed by
the Police.

24 Proof of mischievous propensity

The owner of a dog shall be liable in damages for injury done by the dog,
and it shall not be necessary for the person seeking damages to show a previous
mischievous propensity, or that the injury was attributable to neglect on the part
of the owner of the dog.
PART 6
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

25 Protection of officers of police

The Chief Officer of Police shall with the approval of Cabinet issue directions
as to the method to be followed by constables in destroying dogs in the respective
circumstances specified in this Act, and no constable who, while exercising the
powers conferred on him by this Act, in good faith does or orders or causes to be
done may act in pursuance or intended pursuance of directions so issued, shall be
under any civil or criminal liability in respect of it.

26 No liability where dog wounded

No person who, with the intention of destroying any dog under powers
conferred on him by this Act, wounds or maims the dog shall, except in a case in
which he causes unnecessary suffering to the dog, be under any liability, whether
criminal or civil, for any injury done to the dog.

27 No compensation for destruction of dogs

No compensation shall be payable to the owner of any dog destroyed by
the police under any order made in that behalf by the court under this Act or in
the exercise of powers conferred in that behalf on the police by the provisions of
this Act.

Dogs Act 1966

767

28 Fines not affected by destruction of dog

Where this Act provides for the imposition of a fine for any offence specified
in this Act that fine may be imposed by the Court whether or not the dog in respect
of which the offence has been committed, was destroyed before the fine is imposed.

29 Destroyed dogs

The Chief Officer of Police shall, with the approval of Cabinet, issue
directions for the method of collection and disposal of carcasses destroyed by the
Police under this Act and any directions so issued shall be carried out accordingly.

30 Offences (Generan( �/p>

(1) Every person commits an offence who –
(a) Fails to comply with any duty or obligation imposed on him by
this Act; or
(b) Wilfully makes any false or misleading statement or any material
omission in any application, information, or report to the police or
the Secretary;
(c) Wilfully obstructs, hinders, or resists any person in the exercise or
execution of any power, duty, or function conferred or imposed on
such person by the provisions of this Act.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no
penalty is provided in this Act elsewhere than in this section or in the Niue Act
1966 is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

31-32 [Repealed by 2004/270]

33 Liability of owners of dogs

In any action for damages for the act of a dog in attacking a human being
or any animal, it shall be no defence that the defendant had no knowledge of the
dangerous or mischievous character of the dog.

768 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

769

DOMESTIC FISHING ACT 1995

1995/199 – 10 August 1955

1 Short title

PART 1 14 Powers to apprehend offenders

PRELIMINARY 15 Penalty

2 Interpretation PART 4

SAFETY AT SEA

PART 2

PROTECTION OF FISH 16 Fisheries officer

3

Prohibited use of illegal fishing means

17

Powers and duties of fisheries officer

4

Power to destroy akau Niukini

18

Licensing of boats

5

Seizure and forfeiture

19

Application for a licence

6

Arms Regulations 2005 not affected

20

Grounds for refusal

7

Marine reserves and fono for fishing

21

Duration of licence

8

Effect of a marine reserve or fono for fishing

22

Fees and regulations

9

Bait fishing

23

Seaworthy condition required

10

Restriction on taking of certain species

24

Offences

11

Prohibited exports

25

Personal liability of officers

12

Catch and size quota

26

Offence of obstructing

27

Exemptions and requirements for boats

PART 3

28

Regulations

13

SUNDAY FISHING BAN

Sunday fishing prohibited

29

[Spent]

1 Short title


PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Domestic Fishing Act 1995.

2 Interpretation

In this Act and its Regulations –
“ammunition” includes any cartridges, cartridge cases, gunpowder, bullets,
and shots;
“annual licence fee” means the fee payable under this Act for a licence to
operate a boat;
“boat” means any vessel or sea craft whatsoever whether propelled by
oars or motorised, but does not include –
(a) A canoe;
(b) A yacht not registered in Niue;
(c) A yacht’s tender not used for hire or reward; or
(d) A commercial cargo vessel having a gross tonnage, in excess of 5
tonne;
(e) A barge.
770 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“destructive organism” means any aquatic organism, animal or any plant that is deemed destructive to any part of the marine environment by Regulation;
“Director” means the Director in charge of the Department of Agriculture, Forestry and Fisheries in Niue;
“explosive” includes any article of which an explosive forms part and which
is capable of destructive effect by way of explosion;
“firearm” includes any weapon from which a missile is discharged by the
force of any explosive substance;
“fish” means every aquatic plant (including algae, dinaflagellates, diatoms,
sea grasses) or animal whether vertebrate or invertebrate and including
their eggs, spawn, spat and juvenile stages and includes any terrestrial
vertebrate or invertebrate animal that has marine life phase within its
normal biological life cycle;
“fishing” means –
(a) Searching for, catching, taking or harvesting fish; or
(b) The attempted searching for, catching, taking or harvesting of fish;
or
(c) Engaging in any activity which can reasonably be expected to result
in the locating, catching, taking, or harvesting of fish; or
(d) Fish processing within the fishery waters; or
(e) Transshipment within the fishery waters; or
(f) Any operation at sea in support of or in preparation of any activity
described in this definition; or
(g) Taking or harvesting crabs, and live sea shells along the reef flats
up to high water mark including diving for live sea shells and or
corals;
(h) Taking or harvesting, crustaceans which are carrying eggs to deposit
in the sea, including the Uga, Kalahimu and Kalavi but excludes
the searching for, catching, or taking of any ‘destructive organism’;
“fisheries officer” means any fisheries officer employed in the Fisheries
Division of the Department of Agriculture, Forestry and Fisheries and
includes the director or any person appointed by Cabinet by warrant;
“fishery waters” includes the territorial seas;
“licence” means a licence issued under section 18;
“marine reserve” means a marine reserve declared by Cabinet under section
7;
“net” means a mesh device used to catch fish that can be casted, set or
dragged, it does not including a flying fish net;
“prohibited fish exports” and “protected fish species” when referring to a
species, includes –
(a) A live species;
(b) A dead species;
(c) Any body parts cooked in part or whole.
“quarantine officer” means any quarantine officer employed by the
Department of Agriculture, Forestry and Fisheries or any person
appointed by Cabinet by warrant;
“take” (fish) includes pursuing, catching, removing, or extracting from the
water or laying hold of by any means or device;
“underwater breathing apparatus” means scuba gear, or hooker unit, made
up of an air tank, and requires the use of a mask or mouth regulator;
“vessel” means any boat, aircraft, ship or other sea-going craft.

Domestic Fishing Act 1995

771
PART 2
PROTECTION OF FISH

3 Prohibited use of illegal fishing means

(1) No person shall use –
(a) Dynamite, gelignite, or any other explosive;
(b) Firearms, hand held power heads exempt;
(c) The New Guinea creeper, commonly known as “akau Niukini”, or
any other poison or stupefying agent;
(d) A net which has a mesh size less than a 75mm diagonal
measurement other than for use as a flying fishing net;
(e) Underwater breathing apparatus for the purpose of taking or killing
fish other than for the taking of any destructive organism within
Niue’s waters.
(2) Cabinet may permit the use of underwater breathing apparatus, subject
to such terms conditions and restrictions as Cabinet may impose, for the purpose
of conducting scientific research or for the gathering of data to assist in the
conservation or management of Niue’s fishery resource.
(3) Every person who –
(a) Acts or attempts to act or encourages or induces any other person
to act in contravention of this section; or
(b) Grows or fails to take steps to eradicate akau Niukini commonly
known to be growing on his property, or has in his or her possession
any plant or seed of akau Niukini;
shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months.

4 Power to destroy akau Niukini

Every officer of the Department of Agriculture, Forestry and Fisheries and
every constable acting under the authority and on behalf of the Director shall
forthwith destroy any plant or seed of akau Niukini which he finds possessed or
grown by any person.

5 Seizure and forfeiture

(1) Any constable or any officer of the Department of Agriculture, Forestry
and Fisheries acting under the authority and on behalf of the Director or Chief of
Police may enter and search any place or vessel and may seize and remove any
explosive or other thing or substance which on reasonable grounds he suspects
has been used or is intended to be used in breach or attempted breach of section 3.
(2) On the conviction of an offence against section 3, the court may make
an order declaring any item in section 3(1) so seized to be forfeited, and thereupon
the same shall be deemed to be forfeited to the Government and may be disposed
of as the court directs.

6 Arms Regulations

Nothing in this Act shall be construed to limit the Arms Regulations 2005.

7 Marine reserves and fono for fishing

(1) With the concurrence of the village council and or the Director, the
Cabinet may by public notice declare a marine reserve, or a fono for fishing over
any part of the reef or Niue waters specified in such public notice.
(2) Every marine reserve or fono for fishing so declared shall come into
force on a day specified in the public notice.
772 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) Every public notice issued under this section may in like manner be revoked at any time.
(4) Village councils must advertise and place signs to the effect of a fono to inform locals and tourists.

8 Effect of a marine reserve or fono for fishing

(1) Except as otherwise provided in this section or permitted under any
marine reserve or fono for fishing, no person shall, so long as any marine reserve
or fono for fishing is in force –
(a) Enter the area over which the marine reserve or fono for fishing
has been declared, for the purpose of fishing;
(b) Take any inorganic substance, living material, or matter from within
any such area.
(2) (a) Every person commits an offence against this Act and shall be liable
on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months, who acts or
attempts to act in contravention of subsection (1)(a) or (b).
(b) It shall be a defence to a charge under subsection (1)(a) if the person
charged proves that he or she was not fishing or for the removal of
any destructive organism, or for research purposes for the gathering
of data to assist in the conservation of management of Niue’s Fishery
resource subject to the written approval of the Director.
(3) Nothing in this section shall be construed to affect the rights of Cabinet,
the Director, and the Chief of Police or any person authorised to act on behalf of
any of those persons, to enter the area over which the marine reserve or fono for
fishing has been declared for the purpose of enforcing this Act or of taking samples
of any kind or conducting any other test or examination on which the question of
the continuation or revocation of the marine reserve or the fono for fishing may
depend.

9 Bait fishing

(1) No person shall take the bait fish known as “ulihega” from a bait fishing
area recognised for that purpose by local village custom and during the time of
day determined and promulgated by local village custom for that particular area,
or as may be prescribed by by-law.
(2) The time of day determined or promulgated by local village custom or
prescribed by by-law shall be deemed to include a provision that all bait fishing
groups proceedings to the same general area shall depart from the shore for the
bait fishing grounds at an agreed time where possible.
(3) No net, fish substance, ground or line bait other than coconut may be
used to lure or catch “ulihega” at recognised village bait fishing grounds.
(4) Jigs and other bait may be used at FADs.

10 Restriction on taking of certain species

(1) No person shall take, sell, trade, or export at any time or be in possession
of, or interfere with any crustacean, that –
(a) Is carrying external eggs;
(b) Has had its external eggs, or the egg bearing appendages removed,
by any means; or
(c) Is in its soft shell stage.

Domestic Fishing Act 1995

773
(2) No person shall take, sell, trade, export, or be in possession of, or interfere with, any Uga, crayfish, Tapatapa or clam whose size is less than indicated in the Domestic Fishing Regulations 1996.
(3) Every person who acts in contravention of subsection (1) or (2) commits an offence, and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months, or to both such fine and imprisonment.

11 Prohibited exports

(1) Cabinet may restrict the export of any species of fish and or their meat
or body parts by regulation.
(2) For the purpose of preventing the export of any species referred to in
subsection (1) any constable, fisheries officer, or quarantine officer may without
warrant at any wharf, airport, or other place of embarkation, search any luggage
or cargo, if they have reason to believe or suspect that any person is committing
or is likely to commit an offence against this Act and seize any such products and
will be disposed of in a manner they consider appropriate under Cabinet’s
approval.
(3) Any person who contravenes subsections (1) or (2) or who obstructs a
constable, fisheries officer or quarantine officer in the exercising of his powers
under subsection (2) shall on conviction be liable for a fine of not exceeding 5
penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months, or both such
fine and imprisonment.

12 Catch and size quota

The Director may apply to Cabinet to prescribe by regulation a catch quota
or size limit on any fish species.
PART 3
SUNDAY FISHING BAN

13 Sunday fishing prohibited

(1) No person shall be allowed to fish on a Sunday between 4am and 9pm
within Niue’s fishery waters (territorial zone).
(2) Any person contravening subsection (1) shall be guilty of an offence.

14 Powers to apprehend offenders

Any constable or fisheries officer shall have the power under this Act to
arrest with or without warrant any person committing an offence or whom he or
she has reasonable cause to believe has committed an offence against section 13.

15 Penalty

Any person offending against section 13 shall be liable to –
(a) A fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit; and or
(b) Imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months; and in addition
to any other penalty the court may impose;
(c) Forfeiture to the Government of the sea-craft together with its fishing
gear and all fish taken.
774 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

16 Fisheries officer

PART 4
SAFETY AT SEA
(1) Fisheries officers shall be appointed by the Niue Public Service
Commission.
(2) The office of the fisheries officer may be held in conjunction with any
other office which the Niue Public Service Commission shall consider to be not
incompatible therewith.

17 Powers and duties of fisheries officer

The general powers and duties of the fisheries officer shall include –
(a) The issuing of licences under section 18; and
(b) The commencing of proceedings under section 18 to ensure
compliance with section 18;
(c) Carry out duties as in section 5(1).

18 Licensing of boats

No person shall put to sea in any boat continuously based on Niue, unless
that boat is licensed under this Act, providing that visiting yachts and their ancillary
boats shall be exempt from this Act in so far as they are not at any time used for
hire or reward.

19 Application for a licence

An application for a boat licence shall be made in such manner as the
fisheries officer may by notice prescribe and the fisheries officer may grant or
refuse any such licence.

20 Grounds for refusal

A licence shall not be refused except on one or more of the following
grounds –
(a) That in the opinion of the fisheries officer the boat is not seaworthy; (b) That in the opinion of the fisheries officer the boat does not meet the minimum requirements for safety as prescribed by this Act;
(c) That the person applying for the licence is by order of the court disqualified from holding a licence;
(d) That the fee payable annually for a licence issued under this Act has not been paid;
(e) That the applicant has not yet attained 16 years of age; and
(f) That the applicant is not the owner of the boat and has not obtained
written permission from the owner.

21 Duration of licence

Every licence shall come into force on 1 July and shall expire on the next
following 30 June.

22 Fees and regulations

(1) No licence shall be issued under this Act until the annual licence fee
has been paid.
(2) The annual licence fee shall be as determined by Cabinet by regulation.
(3) The annual fee determined by Cabinet shall be payable for each year.

Domestic Fishing Act 1995

775

23 Seaworthy condition required

No person shall put to sea in a boat unless that boat is in a seaworthy
condition and has the minimum safety equipment on board required under the
regulation.

24 Offences

(1) Every person who operates a boat in contravention of this Act commits
an offence and on conviction shall be liable to –
(a) A suspension of the licence issued for that boat under section 18 for
a term not exceeding 6 months, or to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty
units or both such suspension and fine, and notwithstanding any
other penalty imposed, the court may order the boat to be
impounded by the Government and held until such time as the
Government, acting through the Director, is satisfied that the
requirements of this Act have been met; and
(b) In the case of repeated offending against this Act, in addition to
any other penalty prescribed by paragraph (1)(a), the court may
order the cancellation of any licence issued under section 18.
(2) Any person whose licence has been cancelled under section 24(1)(b)
and who whilst the licence remains cancelled operates a boat in contravention of
this Act commits an offence and shall on conviction be liable to a fine not exceeding
5 penalty units or to an imprisonment for a period not exceeding 6 months, or
both such fine and imprisonment.

25 Personal liability of officers

No officer shall be personally liable for any act done by him in good faith
in the exercise of any duties, powers, or authorities imposed or conferred on him
by this Act.

26 Offence of obstructing

Every person who wilfully obstructs, hinders, or resists any officer in the
execution of any duty, power, or authority imposed or conferred on that officer by
this Act, commits an offence and, except where the Niue Act 1966 provides a more
severe penalty for the same offence, shall be liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units.

27 Exemptions and requirements for boats

(1) Cabinet may on its own motion or under an application in writing
lodged with the fisheries officer exempt any person from this Act and may impose
such terms and conditions as it thinks fit as a condition under which the exemption
is granted. An exemption so granted may be revoked or varied by Cabinet at any
time.
(2) Cabinet shall make regulations prescribing safety requirements for boats having a gross tonnage in excess of one tonne, resident, licensed to fish in Niue’s EEZ or registered in Niue.

28 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as may be necessary to give effect to
this Act, for due administration of it and for the payment of any fees.

29 [Spent]

776 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

777

EDUCATION ACT 1989

1989/130 - January 1989

1 Short title

2 Interpretation

PART 1

25 Parents’ responsibilities

26 Exemption from enrolment

27 Child be sent to a special school

28 Penalty for failure to enrol child

CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION

3 Department of Education

4 Cabinet’s powers and responsibilities

5 General duties of the Minister

6 Delegation of Minister ’s powers

7 Director of Education

8 Appointment of other officers

9 Delegation of Director ’s powers

10 Expenses of administration to be

appropriated by the Assembly

PART 2

LOCAL ADMINISTRATION

11 Prescribing zones of residence

12 School committees

13 Qualifications of members of school

committees

14 Vacancies of school committees

15 Meetings of committees

16 Committee to have management of school

17 School funds

PART 3

ESTABLISHMENT OF SCHOOLS

18 Establishment of Government schools

19 Fees for education

20 Establishment and registration of private

schools

21 Deregistration of private schools

22 School principals

23 Appointment of teachers and other staff

PART 4

ENROLMENT AND ATTENDANCE OF PUPILS

24 Enrolment and attendance to be

compulsory

29 Exemption from attendance

29A Exemption from attendance by children

who have attained the age of 14 years

30 Penalty for irregular attendance

31 Principal to keep records

32 Inspection of attendance

33 Restriction on enrolment

34 Suspension and expulsion

35 Forbidding attendance in certain cases

PART 5

SCHOOL CLASSES, HOURS AND TERMS

36 Classification of pupils

37 Hours and terms of attendance

PART 6

COURSES OF INSTRUCTION

38 Courses in Government schools

39 Religious instruction

PART 7

INSPECTION OF SCHOOLS

40 Inspection of schools

41 Schools to be open for inspection

42 Inspection of school accounts

PART 8

GENERAL PROVISIONS

43 Guidance and counseling

44 Closing of schools in emergency

45 Wilful disturbance of schools

46 Transport assistance

47 Medical inspection

48 Regulations


778 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

To make provision for the education of the people of Niue under article 61(2)

of the Niue Constitution

1 Short title

This is the Education Act 1989.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Department” means the Department of Education constituted by this Act;
“Director” means the Director of Education and includes any person
appointed as deputy of the Director;
“government school” means any school maintained from public funds and
controlled and administered by the Department under this Act;
“Minister” means the Minister of Education;
“parent” in relation to any child, includes the legal adoptive parent or legal
guardian of that child and any person who has actual custody of that
child;
“primary school” means a school providing a 6 year course, or an 8 year
course for pupils entering the school between the ages of 5 and 7 years;
“private school” means any private school that is registered under this
Act;
“pupil” means any person who is enrolled on the register of pupils of any
school and who has not attained the age of 21 years;
“school” means any institution which not fewer than 8 pupils or other
persons normally attend for their education: and includes the assembly
of not fewer than eight persons for that purpose; and also includes any
institution from which regular educational instruction is given by
correspondence; and also includes any class, division or section of any
school; but does not include –
(a) Any institution or assembly in which instruction is given which is
wholly or mainly of a religious character; or
(b) Any institution controlled by a religious organisation for the
purpose of training persons for the ministry of religion or for
admission to a religious order;
“school age” in relation to any child, means any age between the age of 5
years and the age of 16 years or any earlier age at which the child ceases
to be required to have his name enrolled on the register of a school
under Part 4; or in the case of any child who is deemed by the Director
(after special examination by a medical officer or other officer appointed
for the purpose) to require special tuition, between such ages as the
Director many from time to time determine, but in no case shall any
person who has attained the age of 21 years be deemed to be of school
age;
“school committee” means a body of persons established under Part 2.
PART 1
CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION

3 Department of Education

There shall be a department of the Government of Niue called the
Department of Education.

Education Act 1989

779

4 Cabinet’s powers and responsibilities

In pursuance of the responsibilities of Cabinet to establish and maintain
schools for the education of the people of Niue under article 61(2) of the
Constitution, Cabinet shall through the Minister have control and direction of the
Department and of the officers thereof, and, subject to this Act, shall generally
administer this Act.

5 General duties of the Minister

It shall be the duty of the Minister to promote the education of the people
of Niue, and subject to this Act, and to the Constitution to control, administer and
maintain all Government schools and to exercise such supervisory and other
functions in relation to private schools as may be provided under this Act.

6 Delegation of Minister’s powers

(1) The Minister may by writing under his hand either generally or
particularly, delegate to the Director all or any of the powers which are conferred
on the Minister by this Act or any other enactment, including powers delegated
under any enactment, but not including the power to delegate under this section
or the power to consent to a delegation under section 9.
(2) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions or
restrictions attached by the Minister, the Director may exercise any powers
delegated as aforesaid in the same manner and with the same effect as if they had
been conferred on him directly by this section and not by delegation.
(3) Where the Director purports to act under any delegation under this
section, he shall be presumed to be acting on the terms of the delegation in the
absence of proof to the contrary.
(4) Every such delegation shall be revocable at will, and no such delegation
shall prevent the exercise of any power by the Minister.
(5) (a) Unless and until any such delegation is revoked, it shall continue
in force under tenor.
(b) In the event of the Minister by whom any such delegation has been
made ceasing to hold office, it shall continue to have effect as if
made by the person for the time being holding office as Minister
and, in the event of the Director ceasing to hold office, it shall
continue to have effect as if made to the person for the time being
holding office as Director or, if there is no Director in office or if the
Director is absent from duty, to the person for the time being acting
as Director.

7 Director of Education

A Director of Education, who shall be the administrative head of the
Department of Education, shall be appointed by the Niue Public Service
Commission.

8 Appointment of other officers

The Niue Public Service Commission may appoint as officers of the
Department such Deputy Directors, Inspectors of Schools, and other officers and
employees as may be necessary for the purposes of this Act.
780 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

9 Delegation of Director’s powers

(1) (a) The Director may by writing either generally or particularly delegate
to such officer or officers or employee or employees of the
Department as he thinks fit all or any of the powers exercisable by
him under this Act or any other enactment, including any powers
delegated to him under this Act or any other enactment, but not
including this present power of delegation.
(b) The Director shall not delegate any power delegated to him by the
Minister without the written consent of the Minister:
(2) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions or
restrictions attached by the Director, the officer or employee to whom any powers
as delegated under this section may exercise those powers in the same manner
and with the same effect as if they had been conferred on him directly by this
section and not by delegation.
(3) Every delegation under this section shall be revocable at will, and no
such delegation shall prevent the exercise of any power by the Director.
(4) Any such delegation shall until revoked, continue in force under its
tenor, notwithstanding the fact that the Director by whom it was made may have
ceased to hold office, and shall continue to have effect as if made by the successor
in office of that Director.

10 Expenses of administration to be appropriated by the Assembly

All amounts payable for the expenses of the Department, and all amounts
payable for such other purposes as may be necessary to give effect to this Act,
shall be paid out of the money appropriated by the Assembly for the purposes of
this Act.
PART 2
LOCAL ADMINISTRATION

11 Prescribing zones of residence

(1) The Director may, with the approval of the Minister, prescribe zones of
residence of pupils, and any pupil ordinarily residing within any such zone who
is not exempted from attendance at a school under Part 4 or who is not attending
a private school shall attend the Government school which the Director prescribes
as appropriate to that zone.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) the Director may, with the approval of
the Minister, authorise a pupil to attend a school outside such pupil’s zone of
residence if it is proven to the satisfaction of the Director that it is in the best
interests of the pupil to attend that other school.
(3) For the purposes of this section a pupil shall be deemed to be ordinarily
residing in a zone if he is actually residing in that zone.
(4) The boundaries of any such zone shall be notified by the Director in the

Gazette.

12 School committees

(1) (a) For every Government school established under this Act, there shall
be a school committee comprising of 5 members 4 of whom to be
elected by the parents whose children attend that school in the
manner as may be prescribed by regulations made under this Act.
(b) The Principal of each school shall be an ex officio member of the
Committee.

Education Act 1989

781
(c) Where there is only one high school and one primary school for the whole of Niue, then the school committee in each case shall consist of one representative from each village.
(2) If at any time the parents referred to in subsection (1) refuse or neglect to elect a committee, or if for any cause whatever there is no school committee for any such school, the Director shall, until such time when a school committee is elected, be responsible for that school and exercise all the powers and functions of the school committee for that school as provided under this Act.
(3) Every school committee shall hold office for a term of one year, and
any sitting member may be re-elected for any subsequent term or terms.
(4) Elections for school committees shall be held at the beginning of every
calendar year and in no case later than April in each year.

13 Qualifications of members of school committees

(1) A person shall be incapable of becoming a member of a school
committee if that person is –
(a) Mentally disordered under Part 26 of the Niue Act 1966; or
(b) A bankrupt who has not obtained an order of discharge or whose
order of discharge is suspended for a term not yet expired or is
subject to conditions not yet fulfilled; or
(c) A person convicted of any offence punishable by imprisonment,
unless he has received a full pardon or has served his sentence or
otherwise suffered the penalty imposed upon him.
(2) (a) Subject to subsection (1) every parent whose child attends a
Government school shall be eligible to be elected a member of the
school committee for that school and no other person shall be so
qualified.
(b) A parent can only be a member of one school committee at any one
time.

14 Vacancies on school committees

(1) The office of any member of a school committee shall become vacant,
and the vacancy shall be deemed to be an extraordinary vacancy, if the member ­
(a) Dies; or
(b) Resigns from office by writing under the member ’s hand delivered
to the Chairman of the committee; or
(c) Is absent without leave from 3 consecutive meetings of the
committee; or
(d) Becomes a mentally disordered person under Part 26 of the Niue
Act 1966; or
(e) Is adjudged a bankrupt; or
(f) Is convicted of any offence punishable by imprisonment, and is
sentenced to imprisonment for that offence.
(2) Every extraordinary vacancy on a school committee shall be filled by
the election of a new member in the manner prescribed, and the member then
elected shall retain office so long as the vacating member would have retained
office if no such vacancy had occurred.

15 Meetings of Committees

(1) Each school committee shall hold its meetings, elect a chairman, appoint
officers, and conduct its proceedings in such manner as it may determine, except
where it is provided for by regulations.
782 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) If at any time any committee fails from any cause for a period of 3 months to hold a meeting it shall cease to exist and section 12(2) shall apply accordingly.

16 Committee to have management of schools

(1) The committee of every Government school shall have the management
of that school and shall ensure that the school is in good repair and order, and to
provide for the proper cleaning of every such school and the outbuildings thereof,
and make all necessary arrangements in regard to sanitary matters and to the care
of the school grounds, gates and fences.
(2) Every school committee shall expend, in accordance with the instructions
of the Director –
(a) The grants made to it by the Director for incidental expenses; and
(b) The grants made to it by the Director for special purposes.
(3) Subject to the terms of any trust, all other money received by the
committee shall be used in such manner as the Committee thinks fit for the
purposes of the school.

17 School funds

(1) The Director shall from year to year make grants to the committee of
every school for incidental expenses and for any special purpose under regulations
that may be made under this Act.
(2) Such funds obtained under subsection (1) and any donations,
subscriptions, and all other money which may be received by the committee for
the purposes of this Act shall form the School fund for that school, and every such
School Fund shall be kept under regulations under this Act.
(3) Where any school committee ceases to function owing to the closing of
the school the whole of the School Fund in the hands of the committee, after meeting
its outstanding liabilities shall be paid to the Department and credited to the
Department special fund for grants to committees for incidental expenses.
(4) The accounts of every school committee shall be audited by the
Government Auditor under article 60 of the Constitution.
PART 3
ESTABLISHMENT OF SCHOOLS

18 Establishment of Government schools

(1) There shall be established in Niue such Government schools, institutions,
classes, etc, as Cabinet considers necessary for the purposes of ­
(a) Providing pre-school education in the form of kindergartens,
playcentres, and similar institutions;
(b) Providing for primary education;
(c) Providing for intermediate and secondary education;
(d) Providing for special education such as for mentally and physically
handicapped children;
(e) Providing for further and or continuing education such as in the
form of community colleges, etc;
(f) Providing for the training of teachers;
(g) Providing for the training of technical skills, trades, including
cultural arts and crafts;
(h) Providing for any other form of education or instruction which the
Cabinet may determine as necessary and appropriate for the people
of Niue.

Education Act 1989

783
(2) The Director shall advise the Minister as to the number and location of schools and teachers and as to the courses of instruction, which he believes to be necessary in order that the education of the people of Niue may be satisfactorily promoted, taking into account the aims and objects of education as Cabinet may direct or approve.

19 Fees for education

(1) All education provided in Government schools shall be free.
(2) Cabinet may by regulations require fees to be paid in respect of certain
schools, institutions or classes of learning and also prescribe the nature and level
of fees to be paid.

20 Establishment and registration of private schools

(1) Cabinet may, on the application of any person or body of persons
desirous of establishing a private school, approve the establishment of such school
upon such terms and conditions as Cabinet deems fit.
(2) (a) Every such application shall be made to the Director who may
require the provision of any further information as the Director may
require.
(b) Upon satisfaction that all relevant information pertaining to the
application have been obtained, the Director shall as soon as
practicable forward the application, together with any
recommendations, to the Minister for consideration by Cabinet.
(3) On the approval of the application by Cabinet, the Director shall
accordingly register the school as a private school and the registration shall be
notified by him in the Gazette.

21 Deregistration of private schools

(1) The Minister, with the approval of Cabinet, may cancel the registration
of a private school if the Minister is satisfied on advice received from the Director
that –
(a) The school is conducted inefficiently or in a manner which is or is likely to be detrimental to the physical, mental, or moral welfare of the pupils attending; or
(b) Any instruction has been imparted therein to any pupil which is
prejudicial to the peace, order and good government of Niue; or
(c) The school is carried on in premises which do not conform with the
acceptable standards of health and hygiene.
(2) The Director shall give notice in writing of the cancellation of
registration of any private school to the management of the school, and any such
school shall be closed by the management not later than 4 days after the receipt of
such notice. The Director shall also notify the cancellation of registration in the

Gazette.

(3) The management of any private school who contravenes subsection
(2) shall be guilty of an offence under this section and upon conviction shall be
liable to a fine of 0.5 penalty units for every day they remain in breach.

22 School principals

(1) Every Government school shall be under the control and supervision
of a Principal appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission.
(2) The person holding office as Principal of each school at the
commencement of this Act shall be deemed to have been appointed hereunder.
784 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) The Principal shall be responsible for the care, safety, control and discipline of each pupil attending that school.
(4) The Principal of every Government school, shall in carrying out his duties and functions under this Act or in carrying out such further duties and functions as the Director may direct, be responsible to the Director.

23 Appointment of teachers and other staff

There may be appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission such
deputy principals, teachers and special education teachers and other staff to teach
and carry out other duties in the Government schools as may be appropriate.
PART 4
ENROLMENT AND ATTENDANCE OF PUPILS

24 Enrolment and attendance to be compulsory

(1) Every child of school age who is in Niue and is ordinarily resident in
Niue shall, unless exempted under this Part be enrolled at and shall attend,
whenever it is open, the Government school which is appropriate to his zone of
residence, or as directed by the Director under section 11(2) or a private school, or
a special school or any other form of tuition as the Director deems necessary, during
the whole of the period commencing on the child’s fifth birthday (or on the next
ensuing day on which any such school is open) and ending on the child’s sixteenth
birthday.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) any child who will turn 5 during the
duration of any school term shall be entitled to enrol at the beginning of that
school term.

25 Parents’ responsibilities

It shall be the duty of each parent of any child of school age who is in Niue
and is ordinarily resident in Niue to arrange for the enrolment of that child as a
pupil at a school and to cause the child to attend that school and remain at school
during the period provided for in section 24, on every day on which the school is
open and during any subsequent period for which that child remains enrolled as
a pupil at the school, unless the child is unable to attend or remain at school, on
any day by reason of sickness or illness of parent, or other sufficient cause.

26 Exemption from enrolment

(1) The parent of any child who has not completed his primary education
may apply for and receive from the principal of the Government primary school
nearest to his place of residence, a certificate of exemption under this section.
(2) The parent of any child who has completed his primary education may
apply for and receive from the principal of the secondary school nearest to his
place of residence, a certificate of exemption under this section.
(3) Every such certificate of exemption shall exempt the child from the
obligation to have his name enrolled on the register of a school.
(4) No certificate of exemption shall be granted under this section, except
upon the ground –
(a) That the child is elsewhere under instruction as regular and as
efficient as in a Government school; or
(b) That the child is unable to attend school regularly or is unable to be
educated by reason of physical or mental handicap.
(5) Any parent who is dissatisfied with any refusal to grant a certificate of
exemption may appeal to the Director who may confirm or overrule the refusal.

Education Act 1989

785
(6) Every certificate of exemption given under this section shall state the ground of exemption, and a copy of every such certificate shall be forwarded to the Director within 14 days after its issue.
(7) The Director may cancel any certificate of exemption from enrolment granted under this section if he considers that the ground on which the certificate of exemption was granted no longer exists or has become in the particular case no longer such as to warrant the continuance of the exemption.
(8) Where any certificate of exemption from enrolment is granted on the ground specified in subsection (4)(b), the Director may, if he considers that the child would benefit from special education, revoke the certificate of exemption and, by notice in writing, call upon the parent of the child to have the name of the child enrolled on the register of any special school, special class, or correspondence school, or any recognised occupational group providing special facilities for the education of such children.

27 Child be sent to a special school

(1) It shall be the duty of the parent of every child who is of school age and
is suffering from disability of body or mind of such magnitude as to require special
education to take steps to provide efficient and suitable education for the child.
(2) In any case where the parent of the child fails to provide that education
for the child, or is deemed by the Director to be unable to provide that education,
the Director may direct that the child be sent to such special school, or class, or
other institution providing special education as he thinks fit.

28 Penalty for failure to enrol child

(1) Where a child is required to be enrolled under this Act, the parent of
the child commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit.
(2) The payment of any such fine shall not be a bar to further proceedings
in case of further default.

29 Exemption from attendance

(1) The parent of any child may apply for and receive a certificate of
exemption from attendance from the Principal of the school at which the child is
enrolled.
(2) Every such certificate of exemption from attendance shall exempt the
child to whom it relates from attendance in whole or part at school.
(3) No certificate of exemption from attendance shall be granted under
this section except upon the ground –
(a) That the child is unable to attend school by reason of sickness,
danger of infection, infirmity, severe stress of weather, sudden and
serious illness of a parent or other sufficient cause; or
(b) That the road by which the child has to travel to school is not
sufficiently passable.
(4) Any parent who is dissatisfied with any refusal to grant a certificate of
exemption from attendance may appeal to the Director who may confirm or
overrule the refusal.
(5) (a) Every certificate of exemption from attendance shall state the
ground of the exemption and shall be for such period only as the
circumstances require; and no such certificate of exemption shall
be granted for a longer period than 3 months, but any such certificate
may be renewed for a like period during the continuance of the
conditions for which the exemption has been granted.
786

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(b) The Director, being satisfied that the conditions for which the exemption has been granted no longer exist, may cancel any such certificate of exemption.
(6) A child may be exempted from attendance for a period not exceeding 5 school days notwithstanding that no certificate exempting him from attendance has been granted if the Principal of the school attended by him is satisfied that the child has been absent for good and sufficient reason.

29A Exemption from attendance by children who have attained the age of 14 years

(1) The parent of a child who has attained the age of 14 years may apply to the Director for a certificate of exemption from attendance in respect of the child. (2) A certificate of exemption granted under this section exempts the child
to whom it relates from attendance at school.
(3) The Director must not grant a certificate of exemption under this section
in respect of a child until the Director has satisfied himself that –
(a) The child has been offered employment or training; and
(b It is in the child’s best interest that the child should be so employed
or trained instead of receiving instruction at a school.
(4) A parent who is dissatisfied with a refusal by the Director to grant a
certificate of exemption under this section may appeal to the Minister who may
confirm or overrule the refusal.
(5) A certificate of exemption granted under this section must –
(a) State the nature of the employment or training that the child is to
undertake; and
(b) Be forwarded by the Director to the Minister within the 14 days
after its issue.
(6) The Director may cancel a certificate of exemption granted under this
section if the Director is satisfied that ­
(a) The child named in the certificate ­
(i) is not employed or receiving the training specified in the
certificate; or
(ii) has not attended the employment or undertaken the training
on a regular basis; or
(b) It has not proved to be in the child’s best interest that the child
should be employed or trained as specified in the certificate instead
of receiving instruction at a school.
(7) The Director must within 14 days of cancelling a certificate of exemption
granted under this section inform the Minister of the cancellation and the reason
for the cancellation.

30 Penalty for irregular attendance

(1) Where any child required by this Act to attend school has been enrolled
on the register of a school and does not attend, each parent of the child commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day on which the child fails to attend school as required by this Act; but no parent shall be liable to a fine exceeding 0.5 penalty units on conviction for a first offence against this section, nor to a fine exceeding 1 penalty unit on conviction for a second or subsequent offence against this section.
(2) In any prosecution under subsection (1) the onus of proof that any child
is not required to attend school shall be on the person charged.

Education Act 1989

787

31 Principal to keep records

(1) It shall be the duty of the principal of each school to enrol, and to
maintain a proper roll of all pupils enrolled at the school, in such form and manner
as may be required by the Director.
(2) The principal shall also ensure that the teachers keep proper records of
attendance and the principal shall compile a summary of attendance for each school
term which shall be forwarded to the Director at the end of each school term.

32 Inspection of attendance

The Director or any officer of the Department directed by the Director may
carry out inspection of attendance records in every Government school and every
private registered school.

33 Restriction on enrolment

The Director may, with the approval of the Minister, in order to avoid
overcrowding at any Government school, limit the attendance at the school in
such manner as it determines.

34 Suspension and expulsion

(1) (a) Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions it shall be lawful for the
principal of any Government school to suspend from attendance
any child who, from gross misconduct or incorrigible disobedience,
may be considered an injurious or dangerous example to other
pupils, or whose attendance at school is likely for any serious cause
to have detrimental effect upon himself or upon the other pupils.
(b) No suspension of the pupil who is 14 years and under shall be for a
period exceeding one week, except where extended as provided in
this section.
(2) Where any pupil 14 years and under is suspended from attendance
under subsection (1) the following shall apply –
(a) The principal shall immediately notify the parents or guardian of
the pupil and the School Committee (if any) of the school of the
suspension and the reasons therefore, and shall forward forthwith
to the Director a full report of the suspension;
(b) The Director on receiving the report may, after such enquiry as he
considers necessary, either reinstate the pupil conditionally or
unconditionally or extend the term of the suspension for such period
as it deems fit;
(c) Where after reasonable enquiries the Director is of the opinion that
the pupil should not be reinstated in the school from which the
pupil was suspended, the Director shall make arrangements for
the re-establishing of the pupil in some other school providing
education of the same kind which the pupil can conveniently attend,
or if there is no such school available, the Director shall make
arrangements for the pupil to be enrolled with a correspondence
school whether established in Niue or elsewhere;
(d) The name of every suspended pupil shall remain on the register of
the school from which he is suspended until he has been placed at
some other school, or has been enrolled in a correspondence school,
or has been granted by the Director exemption from the obligation
to be enrolled as a pupil of any school notwithstanding section 26(4)
and the suspended pupil shall not be entitled to attend the school
from which he is suspended while the suspension continues.
788 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) Where any pupil over 14 years of age is suspended from attendance under subsection (1), the following provisions shall apply –
(a) The principal shall immediately inform the parents or guardian of the pupil and the school committee (if any) of the school of the suspension and the reasons therefore, and shall forward forthwith to the Director a full report of the suspension;
(b) The Director, on receiving the report shall thereupon investigate the matter as he considers necessary and may direct that the pupil be reinstated conditionally or unconditionally, or he may expel the child.

35 Forbidding attendance in certain cases

(1) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, it shall be lawful for
the principal of any Government school to forbid the attendance at the school of
any pupil on the grounds of want of cleanliness or on the grounds that the principal
has reasonable cause to suspect the pupil is suffering from any communicable
disease.
(2) Immediately on forbidding the attendance of any pupil under this
section the principal shall report to the parents of the pupil, the school committee
(if any), and the Director the action taken by him and the grounds for taking it.
(3) In the case of the pupil whose attendance is forbidden on the grounds
that the Principal has reasonable cause to suspect that he is suffering from any
communicable disease the Principal shall, in addition to making the reports
required by subsection (2) give immediate notice of the case to the Director of
Health.
(4) The Director shall cause an investigation to be made into the case of
any pupil whose attendance is forbidden on the grounds of want of cleanliness
and may direct the pupil to be readmitted or may confirm that his attendance
remain forbidden until the cause of the complaint has been remedied or no longer
exists.
(5) The Director may in his discretion refuse to permit the readmission of a pupil whose attendance at school has been forbidden on the grounds that the principal has reasonable cause to believe that the pupil is suffering from a communicable disease until the parent of the pupil supplies the certificate of a medical practitioner to the effect that the pupil is fit to return to school.
(6) The principal under this section shall not be liable for any action, whether on the ground of mistake of fact or on any other ground, unless the action was done in bad faith or without reasonable care.
PART 5
SCHOOL CLASSES, HOURS AND TERMS

36 Classification of pupils

The Director shall classify pupils under a system of nomenclature which
distinguishes different classes, standard, or forms within schools in accordance
with the stage and nature of instruction provided there, and may amend any such
classification system.

37 Hours and terms of attendance

(1) All schools shall be open during the hours prescribed by the Minister,
with the approval of Cabinet, from Monday to Friday (inclusive of both days) in
each week, except on –

Education Act 1989

789
(a) Statutory holidays; and
(b) Such of those days as the Minister with the approval of Cabinet
may require or permit any school to be closed, provided that in
emergency situations the Minister shall be empowered to act
without prior Cabinet approval.
(2) The period or periods of instruction on any day shall not exceed in
total 5 hours for any pupil under the age of 6 years, or 6 hours for any pupil who
is 6 years of age or older.
(3) All schools shall be open for periods totaling not less than 200 nor more
than 210 days in any calendar.
(4) No school shall remain open for any continuous period or term which
exceeds 15 weeks.
(5) Notwithstanding subsections (3) and (4) the Minister may, with the
approval of Cabinet, increase or decrease the number of school days in any calendar
year, or the number of weeks in any one period or term.
PART 6
COURSES OF INSTRUCTION

38 Courses of instruction in Government schools

(1) Courses of instruction in all Government schools in Niue shall be secular
and of such content and standards which takes into account the following broad
aims, namely –
(a) To adequately equip the people of Niue with knowledge and skills
required to achieve national goals;
(b) To provide the people of Niue with the highest possible standard
of education;
(c) To promote an understanding in the values of learning;
(d) To continue to incorporate Niue’s traditional arts, crafts and values
in education development; and
(e) To continue with the development of bilingualism (Niuean and
English).
(2) All courses of instruction shall be approved by the Minister after
consultation with the Director.

39 Religious instruction

(1) Notwithstanding section 38(1) provision may be made with the approval
of the Minister for religious instruction to be given to pupils of any Government
school for a period not exceeding 30 minutes for any class in any one week.
(2) (a) Such religious instruction shall be observed or conducted under
syllabuses which are not contrary to Government policy and are
given by voluntary instructors who must be approved by the
Minister; and
(b) Such religious instruction shall be of a non-denominational
character; and
(c) No teacher shall be compelled to give such instruction, or to attend
while such instruction is being given against the dictates of his
conscience; and
(d) If a parent of any pupil applies to the Principal of any school for the
pupil to be excused wholly or in part from attendance at religious
instruction, the pupil shall be excused from such attendance in
accordance with the terms of the application.
790 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

40 Inspection of schools

PART 7
INSPECTION OF SCHOOLS
Every Government school and every registered private school shall be inspected by an Inspector of Schools or some other officer authorised by the Director for that purpose, at such times and in such manner as the Director may direct.

41 Schools to be open for inspection

Every Government school and every registered private school shall be
opened at all times to visits or inspections by the Minister, or the Director or a
Deputy Director, or by the Inspector of schools, or by any other person directed
by the Director to visit or inspect the school.

42 Inspection of school accounts

(1) The Director or any officer of the Department appointed by him for the
purpose may inspect the books, records, and accounts of any school committee
established under Part 2.
(2) For the purposes of exercising the powers conferred by subsection (1)
the Director or officer appointed by him may, after giving reasonable notice to the
school committee whose books, records and accounts are to be inspected, enter
into any office, school, or other premises in which the school committee’s books,
records and accounts are kept, or require such books, records and accounts to be
submitted to the Department for inspection.
PART 8
GENERAL PROVISIONS

43 Guidance and counseling

It shall be the duty of the principal of each Government school to give
guidance and counseling to the pupil attending the school and to notify the parents
of any pupil of any condition or circumstances which in the principal’s opinion is
affecting the normal progress of the pupil through the school or is affecting the
relationship of the pupil with the teachers, or with the other pupils of the school.

44 Closing of schools in emergency

Where the buildings or any of them used in connection with any
Government school are wholly or partially destroyed by earthquake, fire, flood or
other unforeseeable cause, and the attendance at the school has fallen to such an
extent as in the opinion of the Minister to warrant the temporary or permanent
closing of the school, the Minister may, notwithstanding anything contained in
this Act or any other Act, direct that the school shall be temporarily or permanently
closed and the school shall be closed accordingly as from the date of the Minister ’s
direction.

45 Wilful disturbance of school

Any person who wilfully disturbs any school, or who upbraids, or abuses
any teacher or other person engaged in the instruction of pupils in the presence of
hearing of the pupils who are then in school, or are then assembled for school
purposes whether in school or not, commits, an offence, and shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

Education Act 1989

791

46 Transport assistance

The Director shall out of such money as may be appropriated by the
Assembly for the purpose provide such school transport assistance as the Director
thinks necessary.

47 Medical inspection

(1) Every pupil in attendance at a Government school shall undergo such
medical and dental inspection and treatment as is provided for such pupils by the
Government of Niue, and any such inspection and treatment provided by the
Government shall be free in all cases.
(2) The consent of the parents shall be first obtained before any treatment
is carried out.

48 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations for all or any of the following purposes –
(a) Providing for the election of school committees;
(b) Providing for the provision and for the keeping of School Funds;
(c) Providing for the establishment of any of the educational institutions
referred to in section 18(1)(a), (d) – (h);
(d) Defining the courses of study which may be given in accordance
with this Act;
(e) Fixing the terms and holidays to be observed in Government schools
and defining the public holidays and other occasions on which any
such school may be closed, and the conditions under which the
Director may grant holidays on special occasions;
(f) Providing for such matters as are contemplated by or necessary for
giving full effect to this Act and for the due administration of it.

792 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

793

ELECTRIC POWER SUPPLY ACT 1960

1960/6 – 1 September 1960

1

Short title

11

Power to alter dangerous radio aerials

2

Interpretation

12

Sale of electrical appliances and fittings

3

Licences required

13

Power to enter on land

4

Inspection

14

Removal of trees

5

Notice regarding repairs or alterations

15

Compensation

6

Power to enter premises

16

General penalty for offences

7

Hindering or obstructing the Director

17

Fines recoverable

8

Offence to repair or interfere with wires

18

Application of fees and fines

9

Stealing electricity

19

Regulation

10

Government not liable for failure of supply

To make provision for the control of electric installations, wiring and appliances

1 Short title

This is the Electric Power Supply Act 1960.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Director” means Director of Works;
“electric line” or “line” or “electric line or work” means any wire or wires
or other conductor, instrument, apparatus, device, or means used or
intended to be used or reasonably capable of being used for transmitting,
distributing, or otherwise conducting electrical energy, or for the
consumption or application of electrical energy used under a licence
under this Act; and includes a telephone line;
“maintenance” includes any alteration, examination, removal or repair;
“owner” includes occupier.

3 Licences required

(1) No person shall lay, construct, put up, place, or use any electric line
except under the authority of a licence issued to him by Cabinet.
(2) Every person who commits a breach of this provision is liable to a fine
not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and where the offence is a continuing one to a
further fine of 0.5 penalty units for each day during which the offence continues.

4 Inspection

The Director may direct any officer appointed by him to inspect any electric
line or work whether such electric line or work is the property of the Government
or not and upon or after such inspection may require that such additions, alterations
794 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
or repairs shall be made thereto as in his opinion are necessary or desirable for the utility and safety of the undertaking and the public; all such additions, alterations or repairs shall be made in the manner to be approved by the Director or by an officer appointed by him for the purpose.

5 Notice regarding repairs or alterations

(1) Where in the opinion of the Director or any officer appointed by him
any additions, alterations or repairs to any electric line or work are necessary the
Director shall cause a notice to be served on the owner of the electric line or work
or on the consumer of electricity setting out the work required to be done and the
time (being not less than 14 days after service) within which such work shall be
completed to the satisfaction of the Director or an officer authorised by him.
(2) If the owner of any electric line or work or any consumer of electricity
refuses or neglects to comply with any such notice issued under this section Cabinet
in addition to instituting any proceedings against any person for breach of this
Act may also discontinue the supply of electricity to the person so offending or
cancel the licence for the continued use of such electric line or work.

6 Power to enter premises

An officer appointed by the Director may at all reasonable times enter any
premises to which electricity is or has been supplied in Niue in order to inspect
the electric lines or work, meters, measuring instruments, fittings and apparatus
for the supply of electricity and for the purpose of ascertaining the quantity of
electricity consumed or supplied, or, where the supplying of electricity is no longer
required or where the Government desires to take away and cut off the supply of
electricity from any premises for the purpose of removing any electric lines, works,
meters, measuring instruments, fittings, or apparatus belonging to the Government
of Niue.

7 Hindering or obstructing the Director

(1) Every person commits an offence against this Act who obstructs or
hinders the Director or any person duly employed or authorised in the exercise of
any power or function conferred on him by or under this Act or any regulation
made thereunder.
(2) No proceedings for the recovery of any fine in respect of any such
offence shall be a bar to an action at law by the Director or person so authorised
by him in respect of any such act as aforesaid but every such action may be
commenced and proceeded with as if no such proceedings had been taken under
this Act.

8 Offence to repair or interfere with wires

(1) Every person commits an offence against this Act who wilfully or
negligently does any of the following –
(a) Repairs, alters, or makes additions to any electric line or work or
permits to be repaired, altered or added to any electric line or work
except by a person acting under the authority either of the Director
or of a licence issued to him under section 3;
(b) Injures or suffers to be injured any electric line or work, meter or
any electric measuring instrument;
(c) Removes, alters or in any way interferes with the index in any
electric meter or electric measuring instrument or knowingly
prevents any such meter or measuring instrument from duly
registering the quantity of electric energy supplied.

Electric Power Supply Act 1960

795
(2) For each such offence the offender shall, in addition to the expenses of making good any damage so occasioned to any electric line or work or any electric meter or electric measuring instrument, be liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit, and to a further penalty not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day after the first day during which any such offence continues.
(3) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this section, Cabinet, in addition to instituting any proceedings against any person for a breach of this section may also discontinue the supply of electricity to the person so offending (notwithstanding any agreement or contract previously existing).
(4) In any proceedings against any person on a breach of this section the existence of artificial means for causing any alteration to the index to any electric meter or measuring instrument or prevention in the registration of electricity supplied to any consumer or for fraudulently abstracting, consuming or using electricity when such electric line or work or electric meter or electric measuring instrument is under the custody or control of any consumer shall be prima facie evidence that such alteration, prevention, abstraction, or consumption has been fraudulently, knowingly and wilfully caused by the person using such electric line or work or electric meter or measuring instrument.

9 Stealing electricity

Electricity is hereby declared to be a thing capable of being stolen within
the meaning of section 188 of the Niue Act 1966 and any person who maliciously
or fraudulently abstracts, causes to be wasted or diverted, consumes, or uses any
electricity shall be guilty of theft and punishable accordingly.

10 Government not liable for failure of supply

No person who is a consumer of electrical energy supplied or sold by the
Government shall have any claim against the Government in the event of any
failure of the supply of any such energy through accident, tempest, drought or
other unavoidable cause.

11 Power to alter dangerous radio aerials

Where in the opinion of the Director any radio aerial by its proximity to an
electric line is likely to be the cause of public or private danger, he shall cause a
notice to be served on the owner of the aerial in terms of section 5 and the provisions
of that section shall apply as far as they are applicable.

12 Sale of electrical appliances and fittings

No person shall sell or keep for sale any electrical appliances or electrical
fittings unless he is the holder of a licence to sell such electrical appliances or
fittings granted by Cabinet.

13 Power to enter on land

(1) Subject to this Act the Government may enter on any land for the
purposes of the construction or maintenance of any electric line or work and may
remain on that land for such time and execute and do all things necessary in
connection with such line or work.
(2) In the exercise of the power conferred by this section the Government
may cut and remove within a distance of 33 feet on either side of a line whether
existing or proposed any trees and undergrowth which interfere or are likely to
interfere with such line.
796 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) Where it appears necessary from the hilly nature of the country the Government may cut and remove any trees and undergrowth within a distance of not more than 3 chains on either side of any such line.

14 Removal of trees

(1) If any tree growing on any land causes or is likely to cause damage to
an electric line or work the Government may cause notice to be given to the owner
of that land to remove the said tree or any part thereof and if the owner of that
land fails to comply with the terms of such notice within the time specified therein
(being not less than 7 days after service) the Government may enter upon that
land and remove the tree or any part of it but so that no unnecessary damage is
done or incurred thereby.
(2) If the rights and powers conferred by sections 13 and 15 shall have
already been exercised in respect of any land no compensation shall be paid in
respect of any tree or part thereof on such land and cut under the powers conferred
by this section.

15 Compensation

(1) Subject to this Act, where in the exercise of the powers conferred any
damage is caused to land the owner shall be entitled to compensation.
(2) Where any such power is exercised with the consent of the owner and
to the extent of such consent no compensation shall be paid.

16 General penalty for offences

Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no penalty
is provided elsewhere than in this section shall be liable on conviction to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 0.5
penalty units.

17 Fines recoverable

A fine incurred under this Act shall except where it is otherwise expressly
provided, be recovered upon the information of any person appointed by Cabinet
in that behalf either generally or in any particular case.

18 Application of fees and fines

All fees and fines levied and received under this Act shall be paid into the
Niue Treasury and shall form part of the revenue of Niue.

19 Regulations

Cabinet may by notice published in the Gazette make regulations –
(a) Prescribing the forms of licences under this Act the conditions on
which such licence may be issued and the fees payable on it;
(b) So as to secure the protection of persons and property from injury
or damage caused, either directly or indirectly, by electrical energy;
(c) Prescribing conditions in respect of the construction, installation,
maintenance, use, management, inspection, and testing of electric
lines or works and of instruments, materials, appliances, apparatus,
accessories, and equipment used or intended to be used in the
construction, installation, maintenance, or use of electric lines or
works or in the application of electrical energy;
(d) Prohibiting the manufacture, importation, sale, and use of any
materials, appliances, accessories, devices, and equipment which

Electric Power Supply Act 1960

797
do not satisfy any prescribed tests or standards, or the use of which may be dangerous to persons or property, or which do not comply with any regulations under this section;
(e) Providing for the removal of lines laid or erected in breach of this Act, and of any line in the use of which any of the conditions of the licence under which it was laid or erected are not observed or complied with, and for the removal or alteration of any dangerous line (whether erected under the authority of a licence issued under this Act or any other Act or not), at the expense in each case of the owner of the line;
(f) Defining what may be deemed a dangerous electric line or work for the purpose of any regulations;
(g) Prescribing conditions for and controlling the supply of electrical energy;
(h) Prescribing fees to be paid in connection with any inspection or
testing authorised by any regulations;
(i) Imposing fines not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for the breach of
any regulation.

798 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

799

ENTRY, RESIDENCE AND DEPARTURE ACT 1985

1985/106 – 1 January 1986

1

Short title

12

Temporary prohibitions

2

Interpretation

13

Inspection of vessels

3

Administration

14

Deportation

4

Application

15

Declarations

5

Application for permanent residence

6

Granting of permanent residence

PART 2

DEPARTURE

PART 1

16

Right to depart

IMMIGRATION

7

Restriction on landing

PART 3

8

Permits

GENERAL

8A

Conditions for granting of permits 17

General powers of exemption

8B

Clearance requirements

18

Regulations

9

Resident under permit

19

Offences

10

Prohibited immigrants

20

[Spent]

11

Application of deposits

To regulate the entry, the residence, and the departure of persons from Niue

1 Short title

This is the Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“applicant” includes the applicant’s spouse and any other member of the
applicant’s immediate family by birth or legal adoption, under the age
or 18 years, who is included in the application;
“application” means the form required to apply for a permit as prescribed
by Regulations;
“Director” means the Director of Health and includes a medical officer;
“immigration officer” means a person appointed under section 3(1);
“Minister” means the Minister of Immigration;
“permanent resident” means any person who has been granted permanent
resident status under section 6;
“vessel” means any ship or aircraft and the meaning of “master”, “voyage”,
“port” and any other such word or words which correspond with
“vessel” shall be extended to have a meaning which corresponds with
“aircraft”;
“visitor” means any person not being a prohibited immigrant who enters
Niue for a period not exceeding 30 days and who is in possession of a
valid passport or other relevant travel document, and includes any one
or more dependant members of the family of such person.
800 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

3 Administration

(1) There may be appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission an
immigration officer who may hold office in addition to or in conjunction with any
office in the Public Service.
(2) This Act shall be administered by the Immigration Officer under the
control of Cabinet.
(3) The Cabinet may delegate to the Immigration Officer all or any of the
functions or powers conferred upon Cabinet by this Act and may in like manner
revoke any such delegation.

4 Application

(1) With the exception of section 15, this Act shall not apply to –
(a) The sea, land and air forces of any Commonwealth country; or
(b) Any person entitled to diplomatic privileges and immunities under
the Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968; or
(c) Any person entitled to consular privileges and immunities under
the Consular Privileges and Immunities Act 1971; or
(d) Any person or class of persons in respect of whom the Cabinet in
its discretion grants an exemption from all of the requirements of
this Act.
(2) With the exception of section 15, Part 1 shall not apply to –
(a) A permanent resident of Niue;
(b) A Niuean who was born in Niue;
(c) A person other than a Niuean who was born in Niue;
(d) A person under the age of eighteen years either of whose parents is
a permanent resident of Niue or, being a Niuean, was born in Niue;
or
(e) A New Zealand citizen permanently residing in Niue prior to 1
January 1996.

5 Application for permanent residence

(1) Any person other than a visitor, who enters Niue on a permit issued
under section 8, wishing to be granted permanent resident status, shall apply in
writing to the Immigration Officer.
(2) Applications for permanent resident status shall be submitted by the
Immigration Officer to Cabinet for its decision.

6 Granting of permanent resident

(1) Cabinet may grant permanent resident status to any person seeking it
provided the following conditions are met –
(a) That the applicant has resided continuously in Niue for a period of
3 years immediately preceding the date of his application;
(b) That the applicant has satisfied Cabinet of his intention to reside
permanently in Niue;
(c) That the applicant is of good character; and
(d) That the applicant has sufficient knowledge of the responsibilities
and privileges attaching to being a permanent resident of Niue.
(2) No applicant shall be entitled to claim any period of service in Niue
under the Niue Public Service or any international organisation for the purposes
of subsection (1)(a).
(3) Any person who has been granted permanent resident status under
this section and who remains absent from Niue continuously for a period longer
than 3 years shall no longer be deemed to be a permanent resident.

Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985

801
(4) Where Cabinet has granted permanent resident status to any person it shall issue a certificate approved by Cabinet and such certificate shall be conclusive proof that such person is a permanent resident.

7 Restrictions on landing

PART 1
IMMIGRATION
(1) No person, other than a visitor to Niue, shall land in Niue from any place outside Niue unless and until –
(a) He shall be the holder of, or named in, a permit under section 8;
and
(b) He shall have made and completed a declaration in such form as
may be approved by Cabinet; and
(c) He shall have deposited or have had deposited such sum as the
Immigration Officer may deem necessary to defray the cost of
transporting such person to a place outside Niue where he will be
permitted to land.
(2) Subsection (1)(c) shall not apply to any person who satisfies the
Immigration Officer subject to such conditions as the Immigration Officer shall
deem sufficient that such person is possessed of the means to enable his
transportation from Niue and his maintenance in Niue pending such
transportation.
(3) Any visitor landing in Niue who does not leave Niue within 30 days
after the day on which he landed in Niue and who is not a holder of or named in,
a permit issued in terms of section 8 to remain in Niue shall be deemed to be a
prohibited immigrant within the meaning of this Act, but such visitor shall upon
his departure from Niue, cease to be deemed to be a prohibited immigrant.

8 Permits

(1) An application for a permit to land or remain in Niue shall be in such
form or forms as may be approved by Cabinet.
(2) The granting of the permit shall be at the discretion of the Minister for
a period of up to 3 years and may be revoked as the Minister thinks fit.
(3) A permit may in the Minister ’s discretion include any one or more
dependant members of the immigrant’s family.
(4) A permit under this section shall be issued in writing in such form or
forms as Cabinet may determine.
(5) No permit under this section shall be of any force or effect in respect of
a person named therein who is a prohibited immigrant within the meaning of this
Act.
(6) If the Immigration Officer is of the opinion that a permit has been obtained by fraud or misrepresentation he may withdraw the permit, and the permit shall thereupon cease to have any effect.
(7) Every permit to land shall cease to have effect at the expiration of 3
years from the date on which it was issued.

8A Conditions for granting of permits

(1) Subject to sections 4, 6, 7, and 17, every application for a permit to land
or remain in Niue under section 8, may be granted by the Minister upon the
grounds that –
802

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(a) The applicant is not a prohibited immigrant under section 10; and (b) The applicant has been sponsored by a permanent resident of Niue who is of Niuean descent, or a company, organisation, business or enterprise established or operating in Niue, or by the Government
of Niue including any statutory corporations or bodies; and
(c) The sponsor has provided sufficient proof to the satisfaction of the
Cabinet as to the sponsor ’s ability to provide for the applicant
suitable accommodation and means for the upkeeping and general
welfare of the applicant, including employment confirmation as
the case may be, and including an undertaking by the sponsor to
the extent that the sponsor guarantees payment for all costs incurred
for the purposes of repatriating the applicant on the expiration of
his permit and for any other debts or liabilities incurred by the
applicant during the duration of his stay in Niue where the applicant
is unable to meet any or all of such costs.
(2) The sponsor’s obligation under subsection (1)(c) shall be for the duration
of the applicant’s stay in Niue, or as the case may be, until the applicant is granted
permanent residence.
(3) Where the applicant is sponsored for the purpose of taking up paid
employment in Niue, it shall be necessary for the sponsor to prove to the satisfaction
of Cabinet that there is no suitable person in Niue who could undertake such
employment and that the applicant is qualified and suited for such employment.
(4) Every application under section 8 shall be duly signed by the sponsor
who shall be deemed to be acting as agent for and on behalf of the applicant.

8B Clearance requirements

(1) In addition to the requirements under section 8A every application for
a permit under section 8 shall be accompanied by –
(a) At least 2 character references of the applicant; and
(b) A police report and health clearances from the relevant officials of
the applicant’s home country; and
(c) Any other information that the Minister may specify or require.
(2) For the purposes of section 8A and of this section, “applicant” shall be
construed to included the applicant’s spouse and any member of the applicant’s
family included in the application.

9 Resident under permit

(1) Every person who has lawfully entered Niue pursuant to a permit
issued under section 8 shall, for the period specified in the permit from the date of his entry, or any extension of that period granted under subsection (2), be deemed to be for the time being lawfully resident in Niue.
(2) The Minister may extend the period during which a person who has entered Niue pursuant to a permit is deemed to be for the time being lawfully resident in Niue, and any such extension may be revoked.
(3) If the Minister is of the opinion that a permit has been obtained by fraud or misrepresentation he may, by notice in writing given at any time to any person to whom the permit was issued or to any person to whom the permit relates, revoke the continuing effect of the permit as an authority for such person to be lawfully resident in Niue.
(4) Any person who having entered Niue pursuant to a permit to land
remains in Niue after the permit has ceased to have any effect shall be deemed to
be a prohibited immigrant within the meaning of this Act, but such person shall
upon his departure from Niue, cease to be deemed to be a prohibited immigrant.

Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985

803

10 Prohibited immigrants

(1) In this Act, “prohibited immigrant” means and includes –
(a) Any person who in the opinion of the Director is a mentally defective
person within the meaning of Part 26 of the Niue Act 1966; or
(b) Any person who in the opinion of the Director is suffering from a
notifiable disease as defined or declared in terms of the Public Health
Act 1965; or
(c) Any person who is notified by Cabinet that such person’s presence
in Niue is injurious to the peace, order, or good government of Niue;
or
(d) Any person who at any time within 2 years prior to the date of his
arrival in Niue has been convicted of or been released from
imprisonment after conviction in any place in respect of any criminal
offence there punishable by imprisonment for more than one year.
(2) It shall not be lawful for any prohibited immigrant to land in Niue.
(3) Any prohibited immigrant may be arrested by any constable and placed
and detained on board the vessel by which he arrived in Niue or on board any
other vessel about to leave Niue, and shall pending his removal by such vessel be
detained in such custody and in such place as the Immigration Officer shall direct.

11 Application of deposits

(1) The monies lodged with the Immigration Officer under section 7 shall
be repaid to the person depositing the same at the end of 3 years from the date of
the deposit or on the departure of that person from Niue whichever shall be the
earlier, but the Immigration Officer shall deduct from the said monies any cost
incurred by the Government in connection with the maintenance of such person
in Niue or his deportation therefrom.
(2) Should the person who deposited the monies die before the said monies
have been refunded, the Immigration Officer shall pay the same to the legal
representative of such person, but less any of the costs aforesaid and the costs if
any of burial paid by the Government.

12 Temporary prohibitions

(1) The Immigration Officer may, by notice in writing under his hand
delivered to the master of any vessel arriving at Niue, prohibit the landing in
Niue of the master or any officer or member of the crew or passenger unless and
until the master shall have executed and delivered a bond, with 2 sureties to be
approved by the Immigration Officer in such sum as the Immigration Officer may
determine, conditioned for the due departure of the master, officers, crew of the
vessel and passengers when the vessel resumes its voyage from Niue.
(2) Until the Immigration Officer by further notice in writing under his
hand delivered to the master of such vessel notifies that a bond as aforesaid has
been executed and delivered to his satisfaction the master or any officer or member
of the crew or passengers of such vessel shall not be permitted to land in Niue.
(3) If the Immigration Officer has reason to believe or suspects that any
person arriving in Niue from beyond the seas or proposing to land in Niue is a
prohibited immigrant, or is proposing to land in Niue in breach of this Act the
Immigration Officer may, by notice in writing under his hand delivered to such
person, temporarily prohibit that person from landing in Niue.
(4) Every notice given under subsection (3) shall, unless sooner revoked,
expire at the end of 48 hours after the time when it was delivered to the person to
whom it relates.
804 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(5) Any person landing in Niue in breach of a notice given under this section commits an offence.

13 Inspection of vessels

(1) For the purposes of ensuring compliance with this Act the Immigration
Officer may board every vessel arriving from places beyond Niue forthwith after
its arrival.
(2) The master of the vessel shall forthwith deliver to the Immigration
Officer the passenger list and crew list, or a true copy of it, and shall truly answer
any questions relating to the passengers and crew which may be put to him for
the purposes of this Act.
(3) The master of the vessel shall make suitable arrangements to the
satisfaction of the Immigration Officer to enable him to inspect and examine each
passenger and each member of the crew, and shall also provide such writing
materials and accommodation as may be required by that officer for the purposes
of his inspection and examination.
(4) The Director shall inform the Immigration Officer as to any person on
board the vessel who in his opinion comes within the restrictions of section 10(1)(a)
or (b).
(5) The Immigration Officer may put such questions as he deems necessary for the purposes of this Act to any passenger or member of the crew.
(6) If the master or any passenger or any member of the crew fails or refuses to answer any question put under this section, or answers any such question in a manner which is false or misleading in any material particular, he shall be guilty of an offence.
(7) If any passenger or member of the crew of a vessel arriving at Niue from a place beyond the seas leaves the vessel before the Immigration Officer has notified the master that all examinations, inspections, and inquiries required to be made under this section have been completed, such person and the master shall each be guilty of an offence.
(8) If any person boards any ship arriving at Niue without the authority of the Immigration Officer he shall be guilty of an offence.
(9) The master of a ship or any officer or members of the crew of a ship if so directed by the master, shall have full power and authority to prevent any person on board the ship landing in Niue in breach of this Act and for that purpose to use such force and means of restraint as may be reasonably necessary.

14 Deportation in writing

(1) Cabinet may in writing order any immigrant to leave Niue in any of
the cases following, that is to say –
(a) If the Cabinet has reasonable cause to believe that such immigrant
is a source of danger to the peace, order, or good government of
Niue;
(b) If Cabinet has reasonable cause to believe that the immigrant is
without sufficient lawful means of support;
(c) If the immigrant is convicted in Niue of an offence punishable by
imprisonment for one year or upwards; or
(d) If the immigrant is convicted of an offence under section 19.

Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985

805
not –
(2) “Immigrant” means a person now or hereafter lawfully in Niue who is
(a) A Niuean who was born in Niue;
(b) A person belonging to any of the Polynesian races whether by pure
or mixed descent who was born in Niue;
(c) A person under the age of 21 years either of whose parents is a
permanent resident of Niue or being a Niuean or any person defined
in paragraph (b) was born in Niue.
(3) If any immigrant remains in Niue for 30 days after the day on which an
order made under subsection (1) is served upon him, he shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or to both.
(4) An order made under subsection (1), duly authorised by Cabinet shall be conclusive evidence that the order has been duly made, and that all steps have been taken, all directions given, and all conditions fulfilled which may be necessary for the validity thereof.
(5) When any such order has been made Cabinet may at the same time or at any time thereafter and either before or after the expiration of the period of 30 days mentioned in subsection (2), order any constable to arrest the immigrant and to detain him in custody until he can be placed and detained on board a vessel about to leave for a port beyond Niue.
(6) No person who has been ordered to leave Niue as aforesaid shall at any time after compliance with the order, or after having been placed on board any vessel about to leave Niue, return to or land in Niue without the authority of Cabinet.
(7) Every person who returns to or lands in Niue in breach of subsection
(5) shall be guilty of an offence.

15 Declarations

(1) No person shall enter Niue from any place outside Niue unless and
until he has made and delivered to the Immigration Officer a declaration in the
form approved by Cabinet and no child shall enter Niue unless and until a
declaration in the said form has been made and delivered as aforesaid on his
behalf by an accompanying adult.
(2) Subsection (1) shall not apply to a person entering Niue as the master
or captain or member of the crew of the ship or aircraft which he enters.

16 Right to depart

PART 2
DEPARTURE
Subject to this Act and to any restrictions imposed by or under any other enactment, every person in Niue shall be at liberty to depart from Niue.
PART 3
GENERAL

17 General powers of exemption

(1) Cabinet may exempt from all or any of the requirements of this Act any
person or class of persons entering or desiring to enter Niue or to remain in Niue.
(2) Any exemption granted by Cabinet under this section shall be subject
to such conditions as Cabinet may impose.
(3) Every person who commits a breach of or fails to observe any such
conditions is guilty of an offence against this Act.
806 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(4) Cabinet may order in writing the person having custody of any person arrested and detained in custody under this Act to release such person from that custody upon such conditions as Cabinet may impose.
(5) Every person released from custody under subsection (4) who commits a breach of or fails to observe any conditions imposed upon his release guilty of an offence against this Act.

18 Regulations

(1) The Cabinet may make all such regulations as may be deemed necessary
or expedient for giving full effect to this Act and for the due administration of it.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the Cabinet may make
regulations for all or any of the following purposes –
(a) Prescribing forms for the purposes of this Act;
(b) Prescribing fees in respect of any matters under this Act and
providing for exemptions from or the refunds of any such fees, in
whole or part, in any case;
(c) Prescribing any procedural matters in relation to any applications
under this Act;
(d) Prescribing any procedural matters in relation to proceedings on
appeal from any decisions on any applications under this Act;
(e) Exempting any class of person from the requirement to obtain or to
hold any permit;
(f) Prescribing conditions in respect of permits or any type of permit;
(g) Prescribing the duration, or maximum duration, for temporary
permits or for any type or class of temporary permit;
(h) Prescribing offences in respect of the contravention of or non­
compliance with any regulations made for the purposes of this Act
and the amounts of fines that may be imposed in respect of any
such offences.

19 Offences

(1) Every person is guilty of an offence against this Act who –
(a) Lands or remains in Niue in breach of any of the provisions of this
Act; or
(b) Wilfully assists any person to evade or contravene any of the
provisions of this Act; or
(c) Obstructs or hinders any officer in the discharge of his functions or
duties under this Act; or
(d) Wilfully assists a prohibited immigrant unlawfully to land or to
remain in Niue; or
(e) Makes any declaration or signs any application under this Act which
is wilfully false or misleading.
(2) In every case where a prohibited immigrant unlawfully lands in Niue
the master, charterer, and owner of the ship by which such prohibited immigrant
was brought to Niue are jointly and severally liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty
units in respect of each such immigrant, and also to defray the expenses incurred
by the Government of Niue in removing any such immigrant from Niue and in
detaining and maintaining him in Niue pending such removal.
(3) A certificate under the hand of the Immigration Officer shall be
conclusive evidence of the amount of any expenses incurred as mentioned in
subsection (2).

Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985

807
(4) Any expenses which are defrayable as provided by subsection (2) shall be recoverable against all persons jointly or any persons severally by whom the same are defrayable as a debt due to the Crown.
(5) Every person to whom a permit has been granted is guilty of an offence against this Act who –
(a) Fails to comply with the conditions, or any of them subject to which
the permit was granted; or
(b) Remains in Niue beyond the time or any extended time for which a
permit was granted or, in case of any such permit revoked by the
Minister, if he does not leave Niue within such time after the
revocation of his permit as the Minister prescribes.
(6) Every person who wilfully makes any false or misleading statement or
representation for the purposes of obtaining any permit under this Act and who
obtains such permit and enters or remains in Niue in accordance therewith is
guilty of an offence against this Act.
(7) Upon the conviction of any person of an offence under subsection (6)
the permit which was obtained by the false representation or statement shall
become of no effect and shall be deemed never to have been granted.
(8) If the master, owner, or charterer of any vessel about to leave Niue
refuses without lawful excuse to receive and retain on board any person to be
deported from or otherwise lawfully ordered under this Act to leave Niue, whether
temporarily or permanently, together with the escort if any accompanying such
person, he is guilty of an offence against this Act.
(9) Any person guilty of an offence against this Act is liable to a fine not
exceeding 5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a period not exceeding 6 months
or to both.

20 [Spent]

808 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

809

ENVIRONMENT ACT 2003

2003/264 – 19 December 2003

17 [Repealed]

PART 3

ENFORCEMENT

18 Proceedings for restraint of breaches of Act

19 Orders of the High Court

20 Civil claims for environmental damage

21 Common law causes of action

Environmental Offences

22 Limitation period for offences

23 Offences

24 Liability of company

25 Company liability in case of bankruptcy

Additional Penalties for Environmental Offences

26 Additional penalties

27 Community service orders

PART 4

MISCELLANEOUS

28 Application

29 Effect of this Act on other Acts

30 Non-exemption from environmental

management responsibilities

31 Environment Officers not personally liable

32 Regulations

SCHEDULE

To allow for the development of environmental policy and law, to establish an Environment Department and to provide enforcement powers to environment officers

1 Short title

This is the Environment Act 2003.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
PART 1
PRELIMINARY
“Act” includes its regulations;
810 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“approval” includes any permit, consent or licence issued under this Act; “Council” means the Environment Council established by section 15; “Department” means the Environment Department established under Part
2;
“development” means any project, undertaking or other activity proposed
by any public authority or any other body or person which may
significantly affect human health or society, the environment, or use of
natural resources;
“Director” means the Director for Environment appointed under this Act;
“environment” includes all natural and social systems and their constituent
parts, including people, communities, and economic, aesthetic, cultural
and social factors; and all aspects of the surroundings of humans
whether affecting them as individuals or in their social groupings;
“judicial officer” means the Chief Justice, a Judge, a Commissioner, or 2
Justices of the Peace sitting together;
“land” includes all things growing on land; buildings and other things
permanently fixed to land; land covered by water, such as reefs and the
seabed of the territorial sea;
“Minister” means the Minister responsible for environmental matters;
“NEMS” means the Niue Environment Management Strategy;
“occupier” in relation to any land means any lessee, licensee, or other
occupant of the land and includes the owner or the agent, or
representative of the owner where there is no apparent occupier;
“public authority” means any Ministry, Department, Division, Board,
agency, authority, statutory body, statutory corporation, or
administrative office and includes a member of staff or other person
who exercises functions on behalf of a public authority;
“rules” includes standards, guidelines, measures, codes of practice,
operational procedures and technical specifications;
“sustainable development” means development that meets the needs of
the present generation without compromising the ability of future
generations to meet their own needs and involves using resources to
improve the quality of human life while living within the carrying
capacity of supporting ecological systems.

3 Objectives

The objectives of this Act are to –
(a) Provide a mechanism for the development of environmental policy
and law;
(b) Establish an Environment Department; and
(c) Provide enforcement powers for environment officers.

4 Matters to be taken into account

All persons exercising functions and powers under this Act shall take into
account the following matters –
(a) The maintenance and enhancement of the quality of the
environment;
(b) The efficient use and development of natural and physical resources;
(c) The concept of sustainable development;
(d) The protection of the water lens from contamination;
(e) The protection of indigenous flora and indigenous fauna and their
habitats;

Environment Act 2003

811
(f) The protection of the coastal zone from inappropriate use and development;
(g) The protection of historic areas from inappropriate use and development;
(h) The relationship of Niueans and their culture and traditions to their lands and historic areas;
(i) The conservation and sustainable use of biological resources; and
(j) Compliance with multilateral environment agreements to which
Niue is a party.
PART 2
ADMINISTRATION

The Environment Department

5 Establishment of the Department

The Environment Department is established by this Act.

6 Functions of the Department

(1) The Department, in addition to any function specified elsewhere in
this Act, has the following functions –
(a) To administer and implement this Act;
(b) To formulate environmental and resource management objectives;
(c) To facilitate the formulation of environmental policies and
legislation;
(d) To design and implement programmes with line agencies for –
(i) environmental planning and natural resources management;
(ii) environmental impact assessment;
(iii) waste management and pollution control;
(iv) nature conservation;
(v) protection of historic areas; and
(vi) such other sectors as may be designated by the Council.
(e) To promote environmental awareness, public information
campaigns, and environmental education;
(f) To review environmental legislation, including this Act, and where
necessary to propose amendments and regulations;
(g) To monitor, and enforce environmental laws and policies;
(h) To act as a secretariat to the Council;
(i) To oversee the formulation of collaborative policies and
programmes with other public authorities and with non­
governmental organisations on environmental matters and to advise
on, promote, and assist in implementing these policies and
programmes;
(j) To promote the study of the environment through research and
surveys, listings, classifications and compilation of databases;
(k) To undertake studies and reports;
(l) To promote community involvement in environmental decision-
making;
(m) To encourage and foster knowledge, innovations and practices
embodying traditional lifestyles that promote the protection,
conservation, improvement and management of the environment;
and
(n) To facilitate compliance with and implementation of multilateral
environment agreements relating to the environment.
(2) The Director shall set priorities for the work of the Department.
812 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

7 Staff of the Department

The Department shall consist of a Director and such other officers to be
appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission as may be necessary for the
administration of this Act.

8 Annual Report of the Department

The Director for Environment shall furnish to the Minister a report each
financial year regarding the operations of the Department and the discharge of its
functions and shall include a copy of the accounts of the Department for that
financial year.

Director for Environment

9 Functions of the Director

The Director is to –
(a) Oversee the efficient, effective and economical management of the
Department;
(b) Give advice to such person as he or she is accountable to on matters
concerning any aspect of the environment and concerning any
function of the Department; and
(c) Carry out any other acts necessary to properly discharge his or her
functions.

10 Power of Director to delegate

(1) The Director may delegate any of his or her functions and powers, other
than this power of delegation, to any authorised person.
(2) In this section “authorised person” means a member of staff of any
government department or statutory authority.

11 Environment Officers

Environment Officers

The Niue Public Service Commission may appoint in writing any appropriately qualified person to be an Environment Officer, including constables, quarantine officers, fisheries officers and public health inspectors.

12 Identification of Environment Officers

Each Environment Officer shall be furnished with an identification card
which shall be produced –
(a) If practicable, on each occasion before the Officer proceeds to act
under this Act; and
(b) On demand.

13 Power of Environment Officer to inspect

(1) It is a condition of every approval issued under this Act that the holder
must permit an Environment Officer to carry out inspections authorised under
this, or any other Act, of any place, other than private residential premises, to
which the approval relates.
(2) The owner or occupier of any place in respect of which an Environment
Officer is exercising powers or carrying out duties pursuant to this or any other
Act, shall –
(a) Give the Officer all reasonable assistance to enable him or her to
exercise those powers and carry out those duties;

Environment Act 2003

813
(b) Furnish all information in relation to the exercise of those powers and the carrying out of those duties that the Officer may reasonably require; and
(c) Not be required to answer a question or give information tending to incriminate himself or herself and the Officer shall caution such person accordingly.
(3) For the purpose of the administration of this Act, an Environment Officer may at any reasonable time –
(a) Enter and inspect any place to which an approval has been issued
under this Act to determine whether any activity is being
undertaken in violation of that approval;
(b) Enter and inspect any place where the Officer has reasonable
grounds to believe that documents pertaining to any offence under
this Act may be found;
(c) Stop and inspect any aircraft, vessel or vehicle to ascertain whether
it, or the manner in which it is being operated, complies with this
Act; or
(d) Require the production of any documents that are required to be
kept under this Act or any other documents that are related to the
purpose for which the Officer is exercising any power or performing
any duty under this Act.
(4) Where a judicial officer is satisfied on evidence in writing made under
oath by an Environment Officer that –
(a) There are reasonable grounds to believe that it is appropriate for
the administration of this Act for the Officer to do anything set out
in subsection (3); and
(b) The Officer may not be able to carry out duties under this Act
effectively without a search warrant issued under this subsection
because –
(i) no person is present to grant access to a place that is locked or
is otherwise inaccessible;
(ii) a person has denied the Officer access to a place or there is
reasonable ground for believing that a person may deny the
Officer access to a place;
(iii) a person has prevented the Officer from doing anything set
out in subsection (3);
(iv) there are reasonable grounds to believe that an attempt by the
Officer to do anything set out in subsection (3) without the order
might defeat the purpose of the inspection or cause an adverse
effect,
the judicial officer may issue an order authorising the Officer to do anything set
out in subsection (3) that is set out in the order, and the order must be exercised
within 14 days of the date of issue.
(5) An Environment Officer may not enter private residential premises
except –
(a) With the consent of the owner or occupier; or
(b) Under the authority of any search warrant issued under subsection
(4).
814 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

14 Power of Environment Officer to seize

(1) An Environment Officer may, without a court order or a search warrant,
seize any thing that is produced to the Officer, or that is in plain view during an
inspection under this section, if the Officer has reasonable grounds to believe that
there has been an offence committed under this Act and that the thing to be seized
will afford evidence as to the commission of the offence.
(2) An Environment Officer seizing any thing under subsection (1) shall –
(a) Inform the person of the reason for the seizure;
(b) Give the person a receipt for the article that has been seized; and
(c) Remove the seized article to a place of safekeeping and deal with
the seized article in the same manner as if it were seized under the
authority of a search warrant.

Environment Council

15 Establishment of the Environment Council

(1) This section establishes the Environment Council.
(2) The Council shall be selected by Cabinet and comprise –
(a) One member from each of the following public authorities: Health,
Planning, Police, Public Works, Community Affairs and the Tourism
Office;
(b) Two members from Agriculture, Forests and Fisheries;
(c) A member to be selected by the Chamber of Commerce to represent
private sector commercial interest;
(d) Two members to represent interest groups or the community
generally, not effectively represented by members in the preceding
paragraphs; and
(e) The Director.

16 Functions of the Council

(1) The functions of the Council are –
(a) To advise the Minister on environmental, planning, development
and resource management policies and on ways of resolving
conflicts between these policies;
(b) To advise the Minister on draft laws and draft rules;
(c) To advise the Minister on how to resolve conflicts in the
implementation of the NEMS;
(d) To review the work of the Department.
(2) Schedule 1 applies to the appointment of members and the procedures
of the Council.

17 [Repealed]

PART 3
ENFORCEMENT

18 Proceedings for restraint of breaches of Act

Without prejudice to the power of the Court to strike out vexatious
proceedings, any person may bring proceedings in the Court for an order to remedy
or stop a breach of this Act, whether or not any right has been, or may be, infringed
as a result of that breach.

Environment Act 2003

815

19 Orders of the Court

(1) Where the Court is satisfied that a breach of this Act has occurred, or
that a breach is likely to occur unless stopped by an order of the Court, it may
make any order it thinks fit to remedy or stop the breach including enforcement
orders, declarations, and injunctions.
(2) Where an injunction or other remedy is sought concerning any
development, the Court must order that no person is required to give an
undertaking as to damages or to provide security for costs.
(3) The Court must not award costs against a person who brings
proceedings to stop any development or who asks for any order requiring
compliance with this Act unless the Court is satisfied that the person has acted
maliciously in bringing the proceedings and that the proceedings have no merit.

20 Civil claims for environmental damage

Notwithstanding the results of any criminal proceedings arising under this
Act, a person who has suffered loss as a result of any environmental incident may
bring civil proceedings which may include a claim for –
(a) Economic loss resulting from a pollution incident or from activities
undertaken to prevent, mitigate, manage, clean up or remedy any
pollution incident;
(b) Loss of earnings arising from damage to any natural resource;
(c) Loss of any natural environment or resource.

21 Common law causes of action

Common law causes of action are preserved under this Act.

Environmental Offences

22 Limitation period for offences

A prosecution for an offence under this Act may not be commenced more
than 3 years after –
(a) The date on which the offence was committed; or
(b) The date on which the evidence of the offence first came to the
attention of the prosecuting body,
whichever is later.

23 Offences

(1) Any person who –
(a) Provides false or misleading information under a requirement under
this Act to provide information;
(b) Does not submit any report or provide information as required
under this Act;
(c) Submits any false or misleading report in respect of any tests or
inspections required pursuant to this Act;
(d) Hinders or obstructs an officer who is exercising powers or carrying
out duties, or attempting to do so under this Act;
(e) Fails to give all reasonable assistance to an officer who is exercising
powers or carrying out duties, or attempting to do so, under this
Act;
(f) Offers or gives any inducement to any person exercising functions
and powers under this Act which might reasonably be considered
to have the purpose of influencing a decision of that person under
this Act;
816 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(g) Fails to comply with any approval, requirement or condition imposed under this Act;
(h) Fails to comply with any approval, requirement or condition imposed by any public authority under this Act;
(i) Does not comply with the terms of any order of the court made under this Act and served on that person;
(j) Is guilty of an offence and liable to a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units or to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 12 months, or both such fine and imprisonment.
(2) Where an offence under this Act is committed or continued on more than one day, the person who committed the offence is liable to be convicted for a separate offence for each day on which the offence is committed or continued.

24 Liability of company

(1) If a company fails to comply with this Act, each person who is a director
of the company or who is concerned in managing the company, is taken to have
failed to comply with that provision, unless the person satisfies the court that –
(a) He or she has no actual, imputed or constructive knowledge of the
failure by the company to comply with the provision; or
(b) He or she was not in a position to influence the conduct of the
company concerning its failure to comply with the provision, or, if
in such a position, he or she used all due diligence to prevent the
failure to comply by the company.
(2) If a company fails to comply with any provision of this Act, each person
who is a director of the company or who is concerned in managing it may be
proceeded against and convicted whether or not the company has been proceeded
against and whether or not it has been convicted.
(3) The company remains liable for any offence committed by it whether
or not proceedings are commenced against the directors or those concerned with
managing the company.

25 Company liability in case of bankruptcy

Where any company commits an offence under this Act, any penalty or
award of environmental damages against that company shall take precedence
over any secured or preferred claim lodged in any action for bankruptcy against
that company.

Additional Penalties for Environmental Offences

26 Additional penalties

(1) The court may, in addition to any other punishment that may be
imposed under this Act and having regard to the nature of the offence and the
circumstances surrounding its commission, make an order –
(a) For temporary or permanent closure or suspension of any activity
or facility or cancellation or modification of any approval if the
activity pollutes or damages human health or the environment
beyond the limits set forth by this Act;
(b) For indemnification of the Government, occupiers, or any person
whose interest is affected by the damage caused to the environment
or to human health;
(c) For replacement and restitution to their natural state of things
affected;

Environment Act 2003

817
(d) For rehabilitation of the environment affected at the cost of the party responsible for the offences;
(e) Directing the offender to compensate any affected party, in whole or in part, for any environmental damage or the cost of any remedial or preventive action taken or caused to be taken as a result of the act or omission that constituted the offence;
(f) Prohibiting the offender from doing any act or engaging in any activity that may result in the continuation or repetition of the offence;
(g) Directing the offender to take such action as the court considers appropriate to remedy or avoid any harm to the environment that results or may result from the act or commission that constituted the offence;
(h) Directing the offender to post such bond or pay such amount of money to the Department or into court as will ensure compliance with any order made under this section;
(i) Directing the seizure and forfeiture of any vessel, aircraft, or vehicle used in the commission of any offence;
(j) Requiring the offender to comply with such other reasonable conditions as the court considers appropriate and just in the circumstances.
(2) Where an offender has been convicted of an offence under this Act, the court may, at the time the sentence is imposed and on the application of the person aggrieved, order the offender to pay to that person an amount by way of satisfaction or compensation for loss of or damage to property or income suffered by that person as a result of the commission of the offence.
(3) Where an amount that is ordered to be paid under subsections (1) or
(2) is not paid within the specified time, a civil judgment may be filed with the
court and that judgment is enforceable against the offender in the same manner as
if it were a judgment rendered against the offender in the court in civil proceedings.
(4) The court may in addition to any other punishment that may be imposed
under this Act impose a fine for each day the offence continues until compliance
is fulfilled.

27 Community service orders

(1) Upon the conviction of any person, the prosecution may make
submissions to the court on the appropriateness of a community service order
and of the availability of any community service work.
(2) The court may sentence a person to a community service order instead
of or in addition to a fine.
(3) The court may order a person sentenced to a community service order
to work under appropriate supervision a specified number of hours for a charitable
or community cause or organisation, and where possible, the work should relate
to environmental matters.
(4) The court may specify whether the Director, a constable or some other
person is to supervise the community service order work.

28 Application

PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS
(1) This Act applies to all areas under the jurisdiction of Niue.
(2) This Act applies to all persons, whether incorporated or unincorporated.
(3) This Act binds the Crown.
818 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

29 Effect of this Act on other Acts

(1) The provisions of this Act apply even if they are inconsistent with any
other law.
(2) Compliance with the requirements of this Act does not relieve a person
from separate compliance with any other law of Niue.
(3) This Act overrides any approval given under any other law or public
authority.
(4) Law, for the purposes of this section, does not include the Constitution.

30 Non-exemption from environmental management responsibilities

This Act does not exempt other public authorities from the execution of
their environmental management responsibilities.

31 Environment Officers are not personally liable

The Director, Environment Officers, staff of the Environment Department,
members of the Council and authorised persons are not personally liable for
anything done or omitted to be done in performing their functions in good faith
under this Act.

32 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make all such regulations as may be necessary or expedient
for giving effect to this Act and for its due administration.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), regulations may be
made –
(a) Prescribing the procedures and requirements for an environmental impact assessment;
(b) Providing for planning and natural resource management;
(c) Prescribing waste management and pollution control measures;
(d) Providing for the regulation of hazardous substances;
(e) Providing for the regulation of hazardous wastes;
(f) Prescribing for the identification of species to be protected and
their habitats;
(g) Prescribing rules for the introduction or control of alien or non­
native species;
(h) Providing for the protection, preservation and management of
historic areas; and
(i) Providing for the rehabilitation of any contaminated or polluted
land.
––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE [Section 16]

Membership and Procedures of the Environment Council

1 Terms of office of members

Members representing the commercial sector and the community hold office for

no longer than 2 years but are eligible for reappointment.

2 Remuneration

(1) Members may be paid allowances including travelling and subsistence

allowances.

(2) The Cabinet is to decide the amount of the allowances.

Environment Act 2003

819

3 Disclosure of financial interests

(1) A member must, as soon as possible after the relevant facts have come to the

member ’s knowledge, disclose the nature of the interest at a meeting of the Council if –

(a) A member has a direct or indirect financial interest in a matter being

considered or about to be considered at a meeting of the Council; and

(b) The interest appears to raise a conflict with the proper performance of

the member ’s duties.

(2) A member makes sufficient disclosure of the nature of the interest in any

matter if the member discloses at a meeting of the Council that the member –

(a) Is a member of, or is employed by a specified company or other body; or

(b) Is a partner of, or is employed by a specified person; or

(c) Has some other specified interest concerning a specified company, or other

body, or a specified person.

(3) A member must, as soon as possible after the relevant facts have come to the

member ’s knowledge, disclose the nature of the interest at a meeting of the Council if –

(a) A matter being considered or about to be considered at a Council meeting

concerns bringing criminal or civil proceedings against a person; and

(b) The member has any personal or financial interest in the matter.

(4) The Council must record particulars of any disclosure made under subsections

(1), (2) and (3) in a book kept for that purpose. The book must be available for inspection

by any person at all reasonable hours.

(5) After a member has disclosed the nature of an interest in any matter, the

member must not be present during any Council deliberation concerning the matter, or

take part in any Council decision concerning the matter, unless the Minister or the Council

decides otherwise.

(6) A contravention of this section does not invalidate any decision of the Council.

4 General procedures

The Council may determine procedures for Council meetings and the conduct of

business at those meetings subject to this Act.

5 Quorum

(1) The quorum for a meeting of the Council is 5 members.

(2) The Chairperson or Deputy Chairperson of the Council must be one of the

quorum.

6 Presiding member

(1) The Minister must appoint the Chairperson and the Deputy Chairperson from

among the members of the Council.

(2) The Chairperson and the Deputy Chairperson must hold those positions for

no longer than 2 years.

(3) The Chairperson of the Council or, if absent, the Deputy Chairperson of the

Council presides at Council meetings.

(4) The person presiding at any Council meeting has the decisive vote and, if the

votes are equal, has a second or casting vote.

7 Voting

A decision supported by a majority of the votes cast at a Council meeting where a

quorum is present is the decision of the Council.

8 Transaction of business outside meetings or by telephone

(1) The Council may carry out its business by circulating papers among all the

members of the Council and a resolution in writing approved in writing by a majority of

those members is taken to be a decision of the Council.

(2) The Council may carry out any of its business by a meeting at which members

(or some members) participate by telephone or other means, but only if a member who

speaks on a matter can be heard by all the other members constituting the quorum.

820 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(3) The Chairperson and each member have the same voting rights as they have at an ordinary Council meeting for the purpose of-

(a) A resolution under subparagraph (1); or

(b) A meeting held under subparagraph (2).

(4) A resolution approved under subparagraph (1) must be recorded in the minutes of the Council meetings.

821

EXTRADITION ACT 1965

[EDITORIAL NOTE. The law on extradition is found principally in the Extradition Act 1965 (NZ) which became law for Niue by the effect of section 320 of the Niue Act 1966. It has been subject to several amendments and these are listed in the Table of Acts in Force in this book. The Act is not reproduced. A reform Bill has been prepared for a new Act to replace the Extradition Act 1965 and the related legislation.]

822 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

F 823

FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT ACT 1979

1979/45 – 1 January 1980

PART 1

PART 5

PRELIMINARY

CONDUCT OF FILM EXHIBITION AND PUBLIC

1

Short title

ENTERTAINMENTS

2

Interpretation

15

Film exhibition restriction

16 Children under 12 years

PART 2 17 Disqualified exhibitor

FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT CONTROL BOARD 18 [Repealed]

3 Film and Public Entertainment Control 19 Late night entertainment prohibited

Board 20 Excessive noise prohibited

21 Public entertainment restriction

PART 3 22 No liquor near entertainment places

LICENSING OF EXHIBITORS 23 Penalty

4 Exhibitor ’s licences

5 Suspension or revocation of exhibitor ’s PART 6

licence PLACES OF ENTERTAINMENT

6 Exhibitor ’s licence dispensed with in 24 Licensed premises

certain cases 25 Attendance of responsible persons

7 Duties of licensee

PART 7

PART 4 GENERAL PROVISIONS

CENSORSHIP OF FILMS 26 Supervision and control by police

8

Appointment of Censor

27

Hindering or obstructing officers

8A

Directions to the Censor

28

Offences

9

Films not to be exhibited unless approved

29

General penalty

10

Application for approval of film

30

Proceedings before High Court

11

Examination of films by Censor

31

Fees and penalties

12

Powers of Censor

32

Regulations

13

Classification of film approved by Censor

33

[Spent]

14

Certificates

14A

Offence to mislead Censor

SCHEDULES

14B

Renter ’s licence

To make better provision for the regulation and control of the exhibition of films and public entertainment

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979.
824 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Board” means the Film and Public Entertainment Control Board
established under section 3;
“Censor” means the Censor of films appointed under section 13 and
includes any assistant Censor appointed under that section;
“Chairman” means the Chairman of the Board;
“Chief of Police” includes any person authorised to exercise or perform
any of the powers, duties, or functions of the Chief of Police;
“exhibitor ’s licence” means an exhibitor ’s licence issued under section 4;
“film” means a cinematograph film; and includes a videotape, and any
other material record of visual moving images that is capable of being
used for the subsequent projection of those images in a fixed sequence
on to any screen; and also includes any part of any such film, and any
copy or part of a copy of the whole or any part of a film;
“film exhibition” means –
(a) The exhibition of a cinematograph film and any part of a
cinematograph film; and
(b) Includes the production of any music, speech or other sound
whatsoever in connection with the projection of a film;
“Minister” means the Minister of Police;
“natural scenery” means the landscape features of nature existing in its
natural state;
“premises” includes any building, enclosure, ground or open-air space;
“projection” means the act of presenting film on a screen by means of a
cinematograph machine or other apparatus;
“public entertainment” means any concert, dance, boxing or any other form
of public entertainment whatsoever;
“renter” means any person who supplies any film to any other person
whether for financial reward or other consideration;
“scenario” means a statement or summary of the plot and of the incidents
depicted in a film.
PART 2
FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT CONTROL BOARD

3 Film and Public Entertainment Control Board

(1) There shall be established a board, to be known as the Film and Public
Entertainment Control Board.
(2) The members of the Board shall consist of –
(a) The Minister who shall be the chairman;
(b) The Chief of Police; and
(c) The Secretary to the Board who shall be appointed by the Public
Service Commission and who may hold any other office which the
Public Service Commission considers to be not incompatible
therewith.
(3) At all meetings of the Board the Chairman, or in his absence such
member as the other members may select, shall preside.
(4) Three members of the Board shall constitute a quorum at any meeting
of the Board.
(5) (a) At all meetings of the Board the decision of the majority of members
present shall prevail.

Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979

825
(b) In the event of equality of votes on any decision the person presiding shall have a second or casting vote.
(6) Subject to this Act, the Board shall regulate its own procedure.
(7) The Board shall cause a proper record of its proceedings to be kept.
(8) Every licence or other document issued by the Board shall be signed
by the Chairman and the Secretary of the Board.
(9) The Cabinet may give the Board directions as to the policy to be adopted
in the exercise of the powers and duties conferred and the duties upon the Board
by or under this Act and the Board shall at all times act in compliance with such
directions.

4 Exhibitor’s licences

PART 3
LICENSING OF EXHIBITORS
(1) Subject to subsection (7), no person shall exhibit, or cause or permit or suffer to be exhibited, any film unless he is the holder of a licence, hereinafter referred to as an exhibitor ’s licence, issued under this section and valid in respect of the exhibition of such film at the premises specified in such licence.
(2) Any person who exhibits, or causes or permits or suffers to be exhibited, any film in contravention of subsection (1) or in contravention of any of the terms or conditions of any exhibitor ’s licence shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(3) Application for an exhibitor ’s licence shall be made, in the form prescribed in Schedule 1, to the Board for the area in which the premises in respect of which the licence is sought are situated.
(4) The Board may –
(a) Refuse an application for an exhibitor ’s licence if it is satisfied that
the premises do not comply with Part 6 or if the applicant is a person
who has been convicted of an offence under this Act; or
(b) Grant such a licence –
(i) generally, in which case the licence shall, unless sooner revoked
or surrendered, remain in force until 31 December following
the date of its issue; or
(ii) specifically, in respect of any period not exceeding 7 days as
may be specified in the licence.
(5) (a) An exhibitor ’s licence shall be in the form prescribed in Schedule 2
and, on payment of the prescribed fee, may be granted subject to
such terms and conditions as the Board considers necessary in the
interests of the safety, health, and convenience of persons attending
any film exhibition held under the authority of such licence.
(b) The Board may remit or waive any fee payable under this subsection
in the case of any film exhibition held for any charitable, educational
or public purpose.
(6) Every exhibitor ’s licence granted under this section shall be limited in
its application so as to authorise the exhibition of films only at such premises as
may be specified in such licence.
(7) Films may be exhibited without an exhibitor ’s licence –
(a) In any premises to which the public are not admitted, for the
purpose solely of entertaining the friends or employees of the
occupier where no charge whatever is made for such film exhibition;
or
826 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) In any hospital, nursing home, institution for the care of the aged or of children, or educational institution, where entrance to the film exhibition, is restricted to the inmates or students and the staff of such hospital, nursing home or institution; or
(c) By any charitable, philanthropic, religious, educational, social or sporting body or organisation where –
(i) the film is exhibited to further the bona fide objects or purposes of the body or organisation, those objects or purposes being film; and
(ii) admission to the film exhibition is restricted to the members of that body or organisation and their families; and
(iii) the public generally is not invited by the public notice or
advertisement, or by any communication of whatever nature
addressed to the public at large, to attend that film exhibition;
and
(d) In any premises which are the subject of a liquor licence issued
under the Liquor Act where no charge whatsoever is made for such
film exhibition.

5 Suspension or revocation of exhibitor’s licence

(1) An exhibitor ’s licence may be suspended or revoked –
(a) By the Board, if in its opinion the safety, health or convenience of
persons attending any film exhibition held under the authority of
such licence is not adequately provided for;
(b) By the Board, if in its opinion the quality of sound and sharpness of
image of any film approved by the Censor falls below a reasonable
standard for public exhibition;
(c) By a court, if the holder of such licence has been convicted of any
offence against this Act.
(2) In the event of an exhibitor ’s licence being suspended or revoked under
subsection (1), the Board shall not grant any further licence to such exhibitor while
such suspension or revocation remains in force.

6 Exhibitor’s licence dispensed with in certain cases

Notwithstanding anything contained in this Part, the Board may, if the
Censor certifies that any film falls within any of the following categories, authorise
in writing any person to exhibit such film in any suitable premises without an
exhibitor ’s licence –
(a) Films depicting wholly or mainly surgical or medical techniques
and intended to be used for instructional purposes;
(b) Films intended to be used wholly or mainly by educational
institutions for educational purposes;
(c) Films intended to be used wholly or mainly by religious
organisations for purposes of religious instruction;
(d) Films depicting wholly or mainly industrial or manufacturing
processes;
(e) Films being wholly or mainly commercial advertisements relating
to the advertiser ’s or sponsor ’s activities;
(f) Scientific films, including natural history films, intended to be used
for educational purposes;

Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979

827
(g) Films depicting wholly or mainly cultural, sporting or recreational activities, and intended to be used wholly or mainly by cultural, sporting or recreational organisations for instructional or educational purposes;
(h) Films depicting wholly or mainly natural scenery.

7 Duties of licensee

Every holder of an exhibitor ’s licence shall ensure that every film exhibition
is conducted in such a manner as to provide for the safety, convenience and good
order of the persons attending the film exhibition and that there is a responsible,
competent and sober person operating the projector used in the premises for the
purpose of the film exhibition.
PART 4
CENSORSHIP OF FILMS

8 Appointment of Censor

(1) (a) The Board shall appoint a suitable person to be the Censor and
such other persons as it considers necessary, to be known as assistant
Censors, to assist the Censor or to act in his stead.
(b) No member of the Board may be appointed as the Censor or an
assistant Censor.
(2) (a) Subject to any directions given by the Censor, every assistant Censor
shall have and may exercise all or any of the powers, duties,
discretion and authorities conferred upon the Censor by or under
this Act.
(b) Every decision of an assistant Censor shall be signified in the name
of the Censor and shall be deemed to be a decision of the Censor.

8A Directions to the Censor

(1) The Board may give the Censor directions as to the policy to be adopted
in the exercise of the powers and duties conferred upon him by or under this Act
and the Censor shall at all times act in compliance with such directions.
(2) The Board may, in giving directions to the Censor under subsection (1),
place a prohibition either totally, or in respect of public or private viewing only,
on films of a particular kind, or films displaying certain kinds of activities, and
such a prohibition shall be binding on the Censor.

9 Films not to be exhibited unless approved

(1) Subject to subsection (2) no person shall exhibit any film (in public or
in private) or make available for rent or exhibition any film unless and until that
film has been examined and approved by the Censor.
(2) (a) The Censor, after considering the application for approval, may
exempt a film from the requirements of examination and may
approve it for exhibition or rent without first examining it if he has
reason to believe that the film as described in the application would
otherwise meet the requirements for approval.
(b) An exemption may be granted absolutely, or subject to such
conditions as the Censor may impose.
(3) (a) The Censor may at any time require a film that was granted an
exemption from examination under subsection (2) to be resubmitted
to him for examination and if necessary classification.
(b) In any such case the earlier approval shall be deemed to be cancelled.
828 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

10 Application for approval of film

(1) Subject to section 14 (2) every application for the approval by the Censor
of any film shall be made in writing on the form prescribed by the Censor and be
accompanied by a scenario of that film and the prescribed fee.
(2) The Censor may dispense in a particular case with the requirement
relating to the submission of a scenario.

11 Examination of films by Censor

(1) Where any film is submitted to the Censor for examination by him the
Censor shall, unless he exempts the film from examination under section 9, as
soon as practicable, examine the film at premises approved for such purposes by
the Board.
(2) The Censor may require any film in respect of which his approval is
sought under this Act to be exhibited before him for the purpose of censorship, at
such time as he may determine and in a place approved by the Board for such
purpose at the expense and risk of the applicant.
(3) Subject to subsection (4) in examining any film under this Act the Censor
may consult any person whom he considers may be able to assist him in forming
an opinion of the film on which to base his decision in respect of the film.
(4) (a) The Board may determine either generally or in respect to any
particular film the eligibility of any person to be present with the
Censor when he is examining a film and that decision shall be
binding on the Censor.
(b) The applicant shall be entitled as of right to attend any such
examination.

12 Powers of Censor

(1) After examining a film for the purposes of this Part the Censor shall
either –
(a) Approve the film for exhibition or rental and classify it in accordance with section 13; of
(b) Return the film to the applicant specifying the part or parts of the
film that would require to be omitted or altered in order to obtain
the approval of the Censor; or
(c) Refuse to approve the film for exhibition or rental.
(2) The Censor shall not refuse to approve a film for exhibition, or rental
other than under a direction under section 8A, without the film having first been
examined under section 11.
(3) The Censor shall not approve any film or any part of a film for public
exhibition which is, in his opinion, indecent, obscene, injurious to morality or
likely to encourage public disorder or crime.

13 Classification of film approved by Censor

(1) The Censor shall give each film approved for exhibition or rental under
section 12(1)(a) one of the following classifications –
(a) Approved for general exhibition; or
(b) Approved for exhibition to persons over the age of 13 years; or
(c) Approved for exhibition to adult audiences only; or
(d) Approved for restricted exhibition.
(2) Any film falling into subsection (1)(d) may be approved subject to –
(a) The condition that such film shall be exhibited only to a specified
class or classes or description of persons; or

Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979

829
(b) Any other condition that the Censor may consider necessary or advisable.
(3) No person shall exhibit or cause to be exhibited any film approved under subsection (1) –
(a) In the case of a film in category (b) to any persons under the age of
13 years;
(b) In the case of a film in category (c), to any person who is not an
adult;
(c) In the case of a film in category (d), except under the conditions
subject to which such approval was granted.

14 Certificates

(1) The Censor shall –
(a) Signify his approval of a film and the category into which he has
classified it or his refusal to approve a film by a certificate prescribed
in Schedule 3;
(b) Keep in his office a register of films in which shall be entered with
respect to each film the several particulars set out in the certificate
issued under this section and such other particulars as may be
prescribed.
(2) (a) A certificate issued under subsection (1)(a) shall be valid for a period
of 2 years from the date of issue.
(b) Where upon the expiry of the said period, application is again made
under section 10 for the approval of the same film, no fee shall be
chargeable therefor.

14A Offence to mislead Censor

Every person commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding
2 penalty units and to forfeiture of the films involved who knowingly misleads or
attempts to mislead the Censor in respect to the content of any film submitted to
him for approval or provides any false information to the Censor about such a
film in the application for approval or elsewhere.

14B Renter’s licence

(1) No person shall rent any film to any person unless he is the holder of a
renter ’s licence granted under this section.
(2) An application for a renter ’s licence shall be made to the Board on the
form provided and shall be accompanied by the prescribed fee.
(3) The Board may grant such renters’ licences and impose such conditions
upon such licences as it considers are necessary to meet the local conditions.
(4) Subject to any conditions imposed by the Board for a shorter term, every
renter ’s licence unless sooner revoked, or surrendered shall remain in force for
one year from the date of its issue, and may upon payment of the appropriate fee
be renewed at the discretion of the Board.
(5) It shall be a condition of every renter ’s licence that the licensed renter
shall not make available for rent any film that has not been approved by the Censor
and shall comply with all conditions imposed by the Censor in respect of every
film made available for rent.
(6) Any person who rents a film, or causes or permits or suffers to be rented
any film in contravention of this section, or in contravention of any terms or
conditions of a renter ’s licence shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units and where applicable to loss of
the renter ’s licence for such period as the Court thinks fit, and to forfeiture of the
films involved.
830 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
PART 5
CONDUCT OF FILM EXHIBITIONS AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENTS

15 Film exhibition restriction

(1) It shall be unlawful to exhibit, or cause or permit or suffer to be exhibited
any film except as provided in this section.
(2) A film exhibition, not being a film exhibition for educational purposes
only, may be given in villages or Alofi on any night of the week except Sunday.
(3) With the written consent of the Chief of Police a special film exhibition
suitable for children may be given, either in Alofi or any village, on any night or
afternoon to be stated in such consent.
(4) A film exhibition for educational purposes may be authorised by the
Chief of Police in any village at any time during school hours; and at night in any
village provided that in respect of any one village not more than one such film
exhibition may be so given each week, and that no such film exhibition shall be
given in any village on any night on which a film exhibition is being given in that
village by a licensed exhibitor.

16 Children under 12 years

Except as provided by section 15(3), no child under 12 years of age shall be
taken or admitted to any film exhibition held at night except on a Friday and
Saturday night.

17 Disqualified exhibitor

Any licensed exhibitor who is disqualified from holding a licence under
this Act shall be deemed to be disqualified from taking any active part in a film
exhibition either as lecturer, raconteur, or in any capacity whatsoever.

18 [Repealed by 1992/169]

19 Late night entertainment prohibited

No film exhibition or public entertainment conducted in any hall, building
or public place in Niue shall be continued after midnight without the prior written
permission of the Board.

20 Excessive noise prohibited

It shall not be lawful for any person conducting or having the control of
any film exhibition or public entertainment to permit such film exhibition or public
entertainment to inconvenience any person not attending or to unnecessarily
disturb the peace.

21 Public entertainment restriction

It shall not be lawful for any person to conduct or allow to be conducted
without the written permission of the Board any film exhibition or public
entertainment on Sunday.

22 No liquor near entertainment places

It shall not be lawful for any person to serve, consume, or be in possession
of any intoxicating liquor in or in the vicinity of any building used for the film
exhibition or public entertainment unless the said building is licensed and has
been granted approval by the Liquor Board to sell liquor in conjunction with the
said film exhibition or public entertainment.

Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979

831

23 Penalty

Any person acting in contravention of this Part commits an offence and is
liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

24 Licensed premises

PART 6
PLACES OF ENTERTAINMENT
(1) No premises shall be used for any film exhibition or public entertainment unless it is licensed under this section.
(2) The Board shall have authority to license premises for any film exhibition or public entertainment and before it issues a licence in respect of such building it shall have regard to the following –
(a) That the premises is provided with an adequate number of exits clearly indicated and so placed and maintained as to readily afford the patrons ample means of egress;
(b) That the doors of all exits are so constructed and maintained as to easily open outwards on being pressed from within;
(c) That the furniture in the premises is so arranged as not to interfere
with the free access to the exits;
(d) That fire appliances suitable to the character of the building are
provided and maintained in good working order to the satisfaction
of the Chief of Police;
(e) That the electrical work, apparatus and appliances are installed and
maintained in accordance with the standard prescribed by the
Electric Power Supply Act and any regulations made under it;
(f) That adequate toilet facilities for the use of the patrons are supplied
to the satisfaction of the Director of Health; and
(g) That the premises are properly ventilated, kept clean and
maintained to the satisfaction of the Director of Health.
(3) (a) A licence granted under this section may be granted in respect of a
particular date or dates, or for a period of time not exceeding one
year, and may be granted in respect of public entertainment
generally, or for one or more particular types of public
entertainment.
(b) A licence shall also specify the particular premises at which the
public entertainment shall occur, and may be granted subject to
such terms and conditions as the Board may determine.
(4) The Board may delegate its functions under this section to one or more
of its members, and may at any time revoke such delegation.

25 Attendance of responsible persons

(1) In order to ensure the safety of the patrons, the person conducting or
having control of any film exhibition or public entertainment, or some responsible
person nominated by him for the purpose, shall be present on the premises during
the whole time of any film exhibition or public entertainment.
(2) All persons responsible for or employed in or in connection with any
film exhibition or public entertainment shall take due precautions for the
prevention of accidents.
832 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
PART 7
GENERAL PROVISIONS

26 Supervision and control by police

(1) All film exhibitions or public entertainment shall be subject to the
supervision and control by the Chief of Police.
(2) A constable at all reasonable times may enter any building in which he
has reason to believe that a film exhibition or public entertainment is being or is
about to be given with a view to seeing whether the provisions of this Act and the
conditions of any permission granted under this or any other Act have been or are
being complied with.

27 Hindering or obstructing officers

Every person commits an offence who prevents the Chief of Police or any
constable from carrying out this Act or who obstructs or hinders the Chief of Police
or any constable in the exercise of any power or function conferred on him by or
under this Act.

28 Offences

Any person who conducts or in any way assists in conducting any film
exhibition or public entertainment in contravention of this Act or of any conditions
or restriction specified in any licence or any permission granted under this Act
shall be guilty of an offence.

29 General penalty

(1) Every person who commits an offence against this Act or against any
regulations made under this Act for which no penalty is provided elsewhere than
in this section shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(2) Where any person who is the holder of a licence under section 24 has
breached any provision of Parts 5, 6 or 7 or a term or condition of any licence
issued under section 24, the Court may, in addition to any other penalty prescribed
by law, and after taking into account the views of the Board, and of the licensee,
either –
(a) Suspend such licence for such period (not exceeding one month) as the Court thinks fit, or
(b) For a second or subsequent offence, and if it is necessary in the
public interest, revoke such licence.

30 Proceedings before High Court

All proceedings under this Act for the recovery of any penalty shall be
taken before the Court.

31 Fees and penalties

All fees paid and penalties recovered under this Act shall be paid into the
Treasury, and shall form part of the general revenue of the Government.

32 Regulations

The Cabinet may, after consultation with the Board, make regulations for
all or any of the following purposes –
(a) Prescribing any fees payable under this Act;
(b) Providing for such matters as are contemplated by or necessary for
giving full effect to this Act and for its due administration.

33 [Spent]

Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979

SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE 1

Section 4(3)

APPLICATION FOR A LICENCE TO EXHIBIT FILMS

833

To the Secretary, Film and Public Entertainment Control Board,

Application is hereby made for a licence to exhibit films in accordance with the following

particulars –

1. Name of applicant: ...............................................................................................................

2. Occupation: ...........................................................................................................................

3. Address: .................................................................................................................................

4. Location of premises where licence is sought: .................................................................

5. Full description of premises (e.g. hall, building or not): ................................................

.................................................................................................................................................

6. Size and nature of premises (state whether licensed or not): .........................................

7. Proposed days and hours of operation: ............................................................................

.................................................................................................................................................

.................................................................................................................................................

8. Proposed charges:

SIGNED by or on behalf of the Applicant:

Signature: .................................................... Date: .............................................................

FOR OFFICE USE ONLY

Application No: ........................................... Date received ....................................................... Previous Applications: ........................................................................ GRANTED/REFUSED Date this application presented to Board: ................................................................................ This application: GRANTED/REFUSED

Terms on which licence granted: ...............................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

834 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

........................................................................................................................................................

...........................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................ Fee payable:

–––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 2

Section 4(5)

EXHIBITORS LICENCE

........................................................................................................ having paid the prescribed fee of $20, is hereby licensed to give film exhibitions in Niue, subject to the following conditions –

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................ Secretary ...................................................... Chairman ....................................................

This licence expires on 31 December 20 ; but it may be revoked by the Board at any time if, in its opinion, the licensee has acted in a manner unfitting him to hold a licence or the licensee contravenes of the conditions laid down in this licence.

––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 3

Section 14(1)(a)

APPROVAL CERTIFICATE OF CENSOR

Niue, .................................. 20 ........... SUBJECT to the undermentioned conditions, the film

................................................................................................................................. submitted by

.............................................................................. is hereby approved for exhibition in Niue.

Film and Public Entertainment Act 1979

Conditions

835
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................
...........................................................................................................................................

836 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

837

FINANCIAL TRANSACTIONS REPORTING ACT 2006

2006/278 – 1 December 2006

OBLIGATION TO REPORT SUSPICIOUS TRANSACTIONS

8 Financial institutions to report suspicious

transactions

9 Supervisory authority or auditor to report

certain suspicious transactions

10 Disclosure of suspicious transaction reports

11 Restrictions on disclosure of certain

information

12 Protection of persons reporting suspicious

transactions

13 Other preventative measures by financial

institutions

PART 4

OBLIGATIONS TO KEEP RECORDS AND VERIFY

IDENTITY

14 Financial institutions to keep records of

transactions

15 Financial institutions to verify customers’

identity

16 Identification required to conduct business

17 Financial institutions to keep records

relating to customers

18 Financial institutions to monitor transaction


838 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

To provide for the reporting of certain transactions

and the keeping of certain records, and for related purposes

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“account” means any facility or arrangement by which a financial institution
does any of the following:
(a) accepts deposits of currency:
(b) allows withdrawals of currency:
(c) pays cheques or payment orders drawn on the financial institution,
or collects cheques or payment orders on behalf of a person other
than the financial institution;
and includes any facility or arrangement for a safety deposit box or for
any other form of safe deposit;
“Attorney-General” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Proceeds
of Crime Act 1998;
“cash” means any coin or paper money that is designed as legal tender in
the country of issue, and includes bearer bonds, traveller ’s cheques,
postal notes, and money orders;
“customer” means anyone to whom a financial service is rendered;
“Department” means either:
(a) The Office of the Attorney-General; or
(b) Any other Department or Office of the Executive Government of
Niue if that other Department or Office is, with the authority of the
Premier of Niue, for the time being responsible for hosting and
supporting the Unit;
“financial institution” has the meaning given by section 3;
“financing of terrorism” means an offence against section 7 of the Terrorism
Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006;
“Minister” means the Minister for Finance;
“money laundering offence” means an offence within the terms of sections
“prescribed” means prescribed by regulations made under this Act;
“serious offence” has the same meaning as in section 4 of the Proceeds of
Crimes Act 1998;
“supervisory authority”:
(a) means a person within the Public Service designated as the “Bank
Supervisor”
(b) in relation to a financial institution that is a company incorporated
under the Companies Act 2006 includes the Registrar (as defined
in Part 13 of that Act); and
“suspicious transaction report” means a report prepared under section 8;
“transaction” has the meaning given by section 4;
“Unit” means the Financial Intelligence Unit established under Part 5.

3 Meaning of financial institution

For the purposes of this Act and every other enactment of Niue, each of the
following is a “financial institution”:

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

839
(a) A bank, being:
(i) a registered bank as defined in section 2 of the Niue Bank Act
1994; or
(ii) the Niue Bank constituted or established by section 4 of the
Niue Bank Act 1994; or
(iii) any other person, partnership, corporation, or company
carrying on in Niue the business of banking:
(b) A person carrying on the business:
(i) as a trustee in respect of funds of other persons; or
(ii) as a trust or company service provider:
(c) A person carrying on a business of an insurer, an insurance
intermediary, a securities dealer, or a futures broker:
(d) A person (other than a person mentioned in paragraph (a), (b), or
(c)) carrying on a business of:
(i) exchanging money; or
(ii) collecting, holding, exchanging, or remitting funds, or
otherwise negotiating funds transfers, on behalf of other
persons; or
(iii) preparing pay-rolls on behalf of other persons, in whole or in
part, from funds collected; or
(iv) delivering funds (including payrolls):
(e) A person carrying on a business of:
(i) issuing, selling or redeeming traveller ’s cheques, money orders,
or similar instruments; or
(ii) collecting, holding, cashing in, remitting and delivering cash
as part of a business or providing payroll services;
(iii) dealers in precious metals and dealers in precious stones when
they engage in any transaction with a customer equal to or
above $10,000 or its equivalent in foreign currency; or
(iv) acting as agents for clients in the buying and selling of real
estate; or
(v) casinos or gambling houses, including a person who carries on
that business through the internet, when their customers engage
in transactions equal to or above $10,000 or its equivalent in
foreign currency:
(f) A lawyer, a notary, an independent legal professional and an
accountant when they prepare for or carry out transactions for their
client relating to any of the following activities:
(i) buying and selling real estate, businesses, and business entities:
(ii) managing client money, securities, or other assets:
(iii) managing bank, savings, or securities accounts, including the
crediting or debiting of accounts or causing this to be done:
(iv) organising contributions for the creation, operation or
management of companies, legal persons or arrangements:
(g) Renting of a safe deposit box:
(h) Any other person prescribed by regulations.
840 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

4 Meaning of transaction

For the purposes of this Act, a “transaction” includes:
(a) The opening of an account;
(b) A deposit withdrawal, exchange, or transfer of funds (in any
currency) whether –
(i) in cash; or
(ii) by cheque, payment order, or other instrument; or
(iii) by electronic or other non-physical means:
(c) The use of a safety deposit box or any other form of safe deposit:
(d) Entering into a fiduciary relationship:
(e) A payment made in satisfaction, in whole or in part, of a contractual
or other legal obligation:
(f) The use of trust or company services:
(g) Any other transactions prescribed by regulations.

5 Application

(1) This Act applies in relation to a transaction conducted through a
financial institution.
(2) A financial institution must comply with the requirements of this Act
despite an obligation as to secrecy, or other restriction on the disclosure of
information, and regardless of whether that obligation or restriction is imposed
by law (for example, by any other enactment) or otherwise.
PART 2
OBLIGATION TO REPORT

6 Financial institution to report financial transaction

(1) A financial institution must report each of the following to the Unit in
writing (which may be given by way of electronic mail) or in any other form and
manner that may be approved by the Minister:
(a) A transaction of an amount in cash that exceeds $10,000 or its
equivalent in foreign currency, or any other amount that may be
prescribed, in the course of a single transaction, unless the recipient
and the sender is a financial institution:
(b) The sending out of Niue at the request of a customer of any electronic
funds transfer that exceeds $10,000 or its equivalent in foreign
currency, or any other amount that may be prescribed, in the course
of a single transaction:
(c) The receipt from outside Niue of an electronic funds transfer, sent
at the request of a customer, of an amount that exceeds $10,000 or
its equivalent in foreign currency, or any other amount that may be
prescribed, in the course of a single transaction.
(2) Subsection (1) (b) does not apply when the financial institution sends
an electronic funds transfer to a person or entity in Niue, even if the final recipient
is outside Niue.
(3) Subsection (1) (c) does not apply when the financial institution receives
an electronic funds transfer from a person or entity in Niue, even if the initial
sender is outside Niue.
(4) If a financial institution fails, without reasonable excuse, to comply with
subsection (1), the financial institution is guilty of an offence punishable on
conviction:
(a) In the case of an individual - by a fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty
units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - by a fine not exceeding 10,000
penalty units.

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

841

7 Offence to conduct transactions for purpose of ensuring no report made under section 6

(1) A person commits an offence, and is liable on conviction to the penalty stated in subsection (3), if –
(a) The person conducts 2 or more transactions or electronic funds transfers that are of an amount below the relevant threshold set out in section 6(1); and
(b) It may reasonably be concluded, having regard to the matters specified in subsection (2), that the person conducted the transactions or transfers in that manner or form for the sole or dominant purpose of ensuring, or attempting to ensure, that no report in relation to the transactions or transfers would be made under section 6(1).
(2) The matters referred to in subsection (1) are –
(a) The manner and form in which the transactions or transfers were
conducted, including, without limitation, all or any of the following –
(i) the value of the currency involved in each transaction or
transfer;
(ii) the aggregated value of the currency involved in the
transactions or transfers;
(iii) the period of time over which the transactions or transfers
occurred;
(iv) the interval of time between any of the transactions or transfers;
(v) the locations at which the transactions or transfers were initiated
or conducted; and
(b) Any explanation made by the person as to the manner or form in
which the transfers were conducted.
(3) The penalty referred to in subsection (1) is –
(a) In the case of an individual - a fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty
units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - a fine not exceeding 10,000 penalty
units
PART 3
OBLIGATION TO REPORT SUSPICIOUS TRANSACTIONS

8 Financial institutions to report suspicious transactions

(1) If –
(a) A person conducts or seeks to conduct any transaction through a
financial institution (whether or not the transaction or proposed
transaction involves cash); and
(b) The financial institution has reasonable grounds to suspect that the
transaction or proposed transaction is or may be relevant to –
(i) the investigation or prosecution of any person for a money
laundering offence, financing of terrorism, or any other serious
offence; or
(ii) the enforcement of the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
the financial institution must prepare a report of the transaction or proposed
transaction and give the report to the Unit as soon as possible, but no later than 2
working days after forming the suspicion.
(2) If a financial institution fails without reasonable excuse to comply with
subsection (1), the financial institution is guilty of an offence punishable on
conviction –
842 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(a) In the case of an individual - by a fine not exceeding 2,5000 penalty units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - by a fine not exceeding 10,000 penalty units.
(3) A suspicious transactions report must –
(a) Be in writing and may be given by electronic mail or by any other
approved form and manner; and
(b) Contain the details specified in the Schedule; and
(c) Contain a statement of the grounds on which the financial institution
holds the suspicion; and
(d) Be signed or otherwise authenticated by the financial institution.
(4) A financial institution that has given a suspicious transaction report to
the Unit must –
(a) Automatically monitor other transactions of the customer who
produced a suspicious transactions report, and report any further
suspicions found; and
(b) Provide to the Unit any further information that it has about the
transaction or proposed transaction or information sent to the Unit
as soon as possible and, in any event, within 2 working days.
(5) If a financial institution fails without reasonable excuse to comply with
subsection (4), the financial institution is guilty of an offence punishable on
conviction –
(a) In the case of an individual - by a fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty
units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - by a fine not exceeding 10,000
penalty units

9 Supervisory authority or auditor to report certain suspicious transactions

A supervisory authority or auditor of a financial institution must report
the information that it has about a transaction or attempted transaction (“the
relevant information”) to the Unit if the authority or auditor”suspects on reasonable
grounds that the relevant information may be –
(a) Of assistance in the enforcement of the Proceeds of Crime Act
1998; or
(b) Relevant to the detection, investigation, or prosecution of –
(i) a money laundering offence; or
(ii) financing of terrorism; or
(iii) a serious offence; or
(c) Related to the commission of –
(i) a money laundering offence; or
(ii) financing of terrorism; or
(d) Evidence of preparations by a person or persons for the commission
of financing of terrorism.

10 Disclosure of suspicious transaction reports

(1) A financial institution must not disclose to any person that the financial
institution –
(a) Is contemplating making a suspicious transaction report; or
(b) Has given a suspicious transaction report to the Financial
Intelligence Unit; unless required to do so under this Act or any
other Act.

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

843
(2) If a financial institution contravenes subsection (1), the financial institution is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction –
(a) In the case of an individual - by a fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - by a fine not exceeding 10,000 penalty units
(3) Nothing in this section prevents the disclosure of any information contained in a suspicious transaction report in connection with, or in the course of, proceedings before a court.
(4) Subsection (1) does not apply to disclosures made –
(a) To an officer or employee or agent of the financial institution, for a
purpose connected with the performance of that person’s duties;
or
(b) To a barrister or solicitor, for the purpose of obtaining legal advice
or representation in relation to the matter; or
(c) To the supervisory authority of the financial institution, for the
purposes of carrying out the supervisory authority’s functions.
(5) No person referred to in subsection (4)(b) to whom disclosure of any
information to which that subsection applies has been made may disclose that
information except to another person of the kind referred to in that subsection for
the purpose of –
(a) The performance of the first-mentioned person’s duties; or
(b) Obtaining legal advice, or representation in relation to the matter.
(6) No person referred to in subsection (4)(c) to whom disclosure of any
information to which that subsection applies has been made may disclose that
information except to a person referred to in that subsection for the purpose of
giving legal advice or making representations in relation to the matter.

11 Restrictions on disclosure of certain information

(1) This section applies to information that will identify, or is likely to
identify, any of the following –
(a) A person who has handled a transaction report in respect of which
a suspicious transaction report has been made:
(b) A person who has prepared a suspicious transaction report:
(c) A person who has made a suspicious transaction report:
(d) Any information contained in a suspicious transaction report or
information provided under section 8(4).
(2) A person must not disclose the information except for any of the
following purposes –
(a) The enforcement of the Proceeds of Crimes Act 1998; or
(b) The detection, investigation, or prosecution of ­
(i) a money laundering offence; or
(ii) financing of terrorism; or
(iii) a serious offence.
(3) No person may be required to disclose any information to which this
section applies in any judicial proceedings unless the Judge or other presiding
officer is satisfied that the disclosure of information is necessary in the interests of
justice.
(4) A person who discloses information in contravention of this section is guilty of an offence punishable, on conviction, by a fine not exceeding
200 penalty units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or both.
(5) Nothing in this section prohibits the disclosure of any information for
the purposes of the prosecution of an offence against section 10(2).
844 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

12 Protection of persons reporting suspicious transactions

(1) No civil, criminal, or disciplinary proceedings may be taken against –
(a) A financial institution; or
(b) An officer, employee, or agent of the financial institution acting in
the course of that person’s employment or agency;
in relation to any action by the financial institution or the officer, employee or
agent taken in good faith under section 8.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply in respect of proceedings for an offence
against a section in this Part.

13 Other preventative measures by financial institutions

(1) A financial institution must appoint a compliance officer to be
responsible for ensuring the financial institution’s compliance with the
requirements of this Act.
(2) The requirement in subsection (1) does not apply to an individual who,
in the course of carrying on his or her business, does not employ, or act in
association with, any other person.
(3) A financial institution must establish and maintain internal procedures–
(a) To screen prospective officers or employees of the institution to
ensure, so far as practicable, that those persons do not have criminal
backgrounds and, in particular, to ensure that they have had no
involvement of any kind in money laundering or financing of
terrorism; and
(b) To make the institution’s officers and employees aware of the laws
in Niue about money laundering; and
(c) To make the institution’s officers and employees aware of the
procedures, policies, and audit systems adopted by the institution
to deal with money laundering; and
(d) To train the institution’s officer and employees to recognise and
deal with money laundering.
(4) A financial institution must prepare a written statement of the
institution’s internal procedures and submit it to the Unit –
(a) In the case of a financial institution carrying on business when this
Act commences, within 3 months after that commencement; or
(b) In the case where an existing written statement has been updated,
within 2 working days; or
(c) In any other case, within 3 months after the financial institution
starts to carry on business.
(5) The supervisory authority of a financial institution must –
(a) Examine and supervise the financial institution to ensure
compliance with this Act; and
(b) Adopt any necessary measures to prevent any person who is
unsuitable from controlling or participating, directly or indirectly,
in the directorship, management, or operation of the financial
institution; and
(c) Co-operate with law enforcement agencies and the Unit, within or
outside Niue, in any investigation, proceedings or prosecutions
relating to money laundering, financing of terrorism or any other
serious offence.

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

845
PART 4
OBLIGATIONS TO KEEP RECORDS AND VERIFY IDENTITY

14 Financial institutions to keep records of transactions

(1) A financial institution must keep the records of every transaction that
is conducted through the financial institution that are reasonably necessary to
enable the transaction to be readily reconstructed at anytime by the Unit.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), those records must contain the
following information –
(a) The nature of the transaction;
(b) The amount of the transaction and the currency in which it was
denominated;
(c) The date on which the transaction was conducted;
(d) The parties to the transaction;
(e) The place and time of the transaction;
(f) The nationality of the parties to the transaction;
(g) Details of any natural person’s valid passport, drivers licence, or
official identification;
(h) Details of any legal entity’s constitution, if not older than 3 months.
(3) The records required by subsection (1) must be kept for at least 6 years
after whichever of the following dates applies –
(a) If the transaction involves an account or is part of a business
relationship, the date on which the account is closed or the business
relationship ceases; and
(b) In any other case, whichever is the later of the following dates –
(i) the date on which the financial institution last obtained
information identifying the parties to the transaction; or
(ii) the date on which the financial institution last received or sent
correspondence relating to the transaction; or
(iii) the date of the transaction.
(4) If a financial institution contravenes subsection (1) or (3), the financial
institution is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction –
(a) In the case of an individual - by a fine not exceeding 250 penalty
units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - by a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty
units

15 Financial institutions to verify customers’ identity

(1) When establishing a business relationship or conducting a transaction
with a person, a financial institution must, before carrying out the transaction,
verify the identity of the person on the basis of any official or other identifying
document or other evidence that is reasonably capable of verifying the identity of
the person.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1) –
(a) If the person is a legal entity, a financial institution must adequately
verify its legal existence and structure, including information
relating to –
(i) the person’s name, legal form, address, and directors; and
(ii) the principal owners and beneficiaries; and
(iii) provisions regulating the power to bind the entity, provisions
to verify that persons purporting to act on behalf of the
customer are so authorised, and provisions to identify those
persons; and
846 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) If the person is a politically exposed person, the financial institution must –
(i) adequately identify and verify the person’s identity as set out in this section; and
(ii) have appropriate risk management systems to determine whether the customer is a politically exposed person; and
(iii) obtain approval of senior management before establishing a business relationship with the person; and
(iv) take reasonable measures to establish the source of wealth and
funds of the person; and
(v) conduct regular and ongoing enhanced monitoring of the
business relationship; and
(c) The financial institution must prescribe the official or identifying
document required for the verification of any particular person or
class of person.
(3) A financial institution must take reasonable measures to ascertain the
purpose of any transaction and the origin and ultimate destination of the funds
involved in that transaction.
(4) If a person conducts a transaction through a financial institution and
the financial institution has reasonable grounds to believe that the person is
undertaking the transaction on behalf of any other person or persons, then, in
addition to complying with subsections (1), (2), and (3), the financial institution
must verify the identity of the other person or persons for whom, or for whose
ultimate benefit, the transaction is being conducted.
(5) If a financial institution contravenes any of subsections (1) to (4), the
financial institution is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction –
(a) In the case of an individual – by a fine not exceeding 250 penalty
units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate – by a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty
units.
(6) Subsection (1) or (2) may be waived in each of the following
circumstances –
(a) If the transaction is part of an existing and regular business
relationship with a person who has already produced satisfactory
evidence of identity or, depending on the transaction profile, if the
transaction is a low risk bulk and regular transaction of institutions
like utilities, pension funds and treasury, unless the financial
institution has reason to suspect that the transaction is suspicious
or unusual, or if the financial institution has reason to doubt the
accuracy or veracity of previously obtained information about the
identity of the person;
(b) If the transaction is an occasional transaction not exceeding 1000
penalty units or its equivalent in foreign currency or any other
amount that may be prescribed, unless the financial institution has
reason to suspect that the transaction is suspicious or unusual;
(c) any other circumstances that may be prescribed.
(7) For the purposes of subsection (6), “occasional transaction” means any
transaction involving cash that is conducted by any person otherwise than through
an account in respect of which the person is the holder.

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

847

16 Identification required to conduct business

If satisfactory evidence of the customer ’s identity is not produced to, or
obtained by, a financial institution under ’section 15, the financial institution must
not proceed any further with the transaction unless directed to do so by the Unit.

17 Financial institutions to keep records relating to customers

(1) A financial institution must keep –
(a) If evidence of a person’s identity (“the identified person”) is
obtained under section 15, a record that indicates the kind of
evidence that was obtained, and comprises either a copy of the
evidence or information that enables a copy of it to be obtained;
and
(b) A record of all correspondence between the identified person and
the financial institution.
(2) The records referred to in subsection (1) must be kept for at least 6 years
after whichever of the following dates applies –
(a) If the transaction involves an account or is part of a business
relationship, the date on which the account is closed or the business
relationship ceases; and
(b) In any other case, whichever is the later of the following dates:
(i) the date on which the financial institution last obtained
evidence of a person’s identity; or
(ii) the date on which the financial institution last received
correspondence from, or sent correspondence to, the identified
person; or
(iii) the date of the transaction.
(3) If a financial institution contravenes subsection (1)or (2), the financial
institution is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction –
(a) In the case of an individual – by a fine not exceeding 250 penalty
units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or both; or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - by a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty
units

18 Financial institutions to monitor transaction

(1) A financial institution must pay special attention to the following if
they have no apparent or visible economic or lawful purpose –
(a) Transactions that are complex, large, or unusual;
(b) Unusual patterns of transactions.
(2) A financial institution must pay special attention to the following –
(a) Business relationships and transactions with persons in jurisdictions
that do not have adequate systems in place to prevent or deter
money laundering or the financing of terrorism;
(b) Wire transfers that do not contain complete originator information.
(3) In relation to subsections (1) and (2), a financial institution –
(a) Must examine as far as possible the background and purpose of
the transactions or business relations and record its findings in
writing; and
(b) On request, must make available those findings to the Unit or to a
law enforcement agency to assist the Unit or agency in an
investigation relating to any of the following offences:
(i) a money laundering offence;
(ii) a serious offence;
(iii) financing of terrorism.
848 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

19 Financial institutions to include originator information with funds transfers

A financial institution must include accurate originator information on electronic funds transfers and on any other form of funds transfers and that information must remain with the transfers, except where –
(a) The electronic funds transfers or any other form of funds transfer
result from a transaction carried out using a credit card or debit
card, and provided that the credit or debit card number is included
in the information accompanying the transfers (except in the case
where the credit or debit card is used as a means of payment to
effect the electronic funds transfers or any other form of funds
transfer, where the requisite originator information must be
included and is to remain with the transfers); or
(b) The electronic funds transfers are transfers or settlements between
financial institutions, and where the originator and beneficiary of
the transfers are acting on their own behalf.
PART 5
FINANCIAL INTELLIGENCE UNIT

20 Establishment of Financial Intelligence Unit

(1) The Financial Intelligence Unit is hereby established.
(2) The Unit operates within the Department.

21 Functions and powers of the Unit

(1) The Unit has the following functions –
(a) To receive and analyse suspicious transactions reports and any other
information given to, or obtained by the Unit; and
(b) To disseminate information based on reports received under
paragraph (a) –
(i) to the Department; and
(ii) if the Attorney-General considers it appropriate, to the police,
a law enforcement agency (whether within or outside Niue),
or a supervisory body outside Niue; and
(c) To conduct examinations to ensure compliance with this Act by
financial institutions; and
(d) To receive information from, and otherwise assist, the Department
the police, a law enforcement agency (whether within or outside
Niue), or a supervisory body outside Niue, in relation to –
(i) the detection, investigation or prosecution of a money
laundering offence, financing of terrorism, or a serious offence;
or
(ii) the enforcement of the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998; and
(e) to issue guidelines to financial institutions in relation to transaction
record keeping and reporting obligations and measures to prevent
the misuse of the financial institutions; and
(f) to provide training programmes for financial institutions about
transaction record keeping and reporting obligations; and
(g) to prepare and present an annual report to the Niue Assembly.
(2) The Unit may collect, free of charge and at the Unit’s request, any
information the Unit considers relevant to money laundering, financing of
terrorism, and serious offences, whether or not that information is publicly
available, including information that is collected or maintained in databases
maintained by the Government.

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

849
(3) The head of the Unit is responsible for ensuring that the Unit performs its functions properly, efficiently, and effectively, and must report to the Minister of Finance quarterly.
(4) The Public Service Commission must appoint –
(a) The Attorney-General or another employee of the Niue Public
Service as the head of the Unit (who may exercise and perform the
functions, powers, and duties of a member of the Unit, and report
to the Minister); and
(b) Employees of the Niue Public Service as members of the Unit (who
report to the head of the Unit).
(5) Until an appointment is made under subsection (4) the Attorney-
General must be taken to have been appointed under that subsection as the head
of the Unit.
(6) A member of the Unit –
(a) May enter the premises of any financial institution during ordinary
business hours to inspect any records kept by the institution under
Part 4, and make notes and take copies of the whole or any part of
the record; and
(b) May send any information derived from that inspection to the
organisations mentioned in paragraph (1) (b); and
(c) May analyse and assess all reports and information; and
(d) May direct any financial institution or Government institution to
take appropriate steps to facilitate any investigation being
conducted by the Unit.

22 Agreements for information exchange with outside agencies

(1) In this section “agreement” means an agreement or arrangement in
writing that relates to the exchange of information between the Unit and any law enforcement agency or supervisory body outside Niue.
(2) The Unit may, with the Minister ’s approval, enter into an agreement with any of the following –
(a) An institution or an agency of a foreign State, or an international
organisation established by Governments of foreign states, that has
powers and duties similar to those of the Unit;
(b) Any other law enforcement agency or supervisory body outside
Niue.
(3) The agreement must restrict the use of information to purposes relevant
to the detection, investigation, or prosecution of –
(a) A money laundering offence; or
(b) A serious offence;
(c) Financing of terrorism; or
(d) An offence that is substantially similar to an offence referred to in
any of paragraphs (a) to (c).
(4) The agreement must also stipulate that the information must be treated
in a confidential manner and must not be further disclosed without the express
consent of the Unit or the relevant law enforcement agency or supervisory body
outside Niue.
850 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

23 Search warrants

(1) A member of the Unit may apply to a Judge of the High Court for a
warrant –
(a) To enter premises belonging to, or in the possession or control of, a financial institution or of any officer or employee of the institution; and
(b) To search the premises and remove any document, material, or thing on the premises.
(2) The Judge must grant the application if he or she is satisfied that there
are reasonable grounds for believing that –
(a) The financial institution has failed to keep a transaction record or
report a suspicious transaction as required by this Act; or
(b) An officer or employee of a financial institution is committing, has
committed, or is about to commit, a money laundering offence.

24 Secrecy provision

(1) This section applies to a person while the person is, or after the person
ceases to be, an officer, employee, or agent of the Unit, of the Department, or of
the police.
(2) The person must not, directly or indirectly, divulge or communicate to
any other person, or make a record of –
(a) Any information contained in a suspicious transaction report; or
(b) Any information provided under section 21(1)(d) or any other
provision of this Act; or
(c) Any other sensitive information to which the person is or was directly
or indirectly privy to in the carrying out of the tasks of the Unit;
except for one or more of the following purposes –
(d) The detection, investigation or prosecution of a money laundering
offence, financing of terrorism or any other serious offence;
(e) The enforcement of the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
(f) The exercise or performance of the person’s functions, powers, or
duties under this Act;
(g) Obtaining of legal advice or representation in relation to the matter.
(3) Despite subsection (2)(b), nothing in this section applies to information
disclosed to a person under section 25 or section 26.
(4) If a person contravenes subsection (2) that person is guilty of an offence
punishable on conviction by a fine of not more than 200 penalty units or
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years or both.

25 Direction to disclose information

(1) The Attorney-General may issue a direction to the person in charge of
a financial institution, Government department, or statutory body requiring that
person to disclose to the Attorney-General, or to a police officer nominated by the
Attorney-General in the direction, a document or other information –
(a) That is not readily available to the public; and
(b) To which that person may reasonably have access, or that is in the
possession or under the control of that person.
(2) However, the Attorney-General may issue the direction only if satisfied
that the document or other information is relevant to any or all of the following
purposes:

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

851
(a) The enforcement of this Act;
(b) The detection, investigation, or prosecution of –
(i) a money laundering offence;
(ii) financing of terrorism;
(iii) a serious offence.
(3) The direction must be complied with by the person to whom it is issued,
and applies notwithstanding any provision in any other law.

26 Secrecy of information disclosed under direction

(1) No person to whom information has been disclosed under a direction
under section 25 must, directly or indirectly, divulge or communicate
to any other person, or otherwise further disclose, or make a record of, the
information, except for any or all of the following purposes –
(a) the enforcement of this Act;
(b) the detection, investigation, or prosecution of –
(i) a money laundering offence;
(ii) financing of terrorism;
(iii) a serious offence.
(2) A person to whom information has been disclosed in accordance with
subsection(1) or with this subsection must not disclose the information to
another person except for a purpose referred to in subsection (1)(a) or (b).
(3) Where information is communicated to a person under a direction under
section 25 or subsection (1) or (2), the person –
(a) Must not voluntarily give the information in evidence in a
proceeding before the Court other than a proceeding for a purpose
referred to in subsection (1)(a) or (b); and
(b) Must not be required to communicate the information to the
Court.
(4) A person who discloses information in contravention of this section is
guilty of an offence punishable, on conviction, by a fine not exceeding
200 penalty units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or both.

27 Evidential value of copies

(1) If a document is examined or provided pursuant to a direction under
section 25 –
(a) The person by whom it is examined or to whom it is provided, or
any officer or person authorised for the purpose by the recipient
of the direction, may make or cause to be made one or more
copies of the document; and
(b) A certified copy of the document is evidence of the nature and
content of the original document, and has the same probative
force as the original document would have had if it had been
proved in the ordinary way.
(2) In subsection (1) –
“certified copy of the document”, in relation to a document examined or
provided pursuant to a direction under section 25, means a copy of the
document purporting to be certified –
(a) By the recipient of the direction; and
(b) As a copy made pursuant to this section; and
“recipient of the direction” means the person in charge of the relevant
financial institution, Government department, or statutory body.
852 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

28 Protection of persons complying with directions

(1) This section applies to an action taken –
(a) In compliance or purported compliance with a direction under
section 25; and
(b) By an officer, employee, or agent of a financial institution,
Government department, or statutory body acting in good faith
and in the performance of that person’s functions, powers, or duties,
or in the course of that person’s employment or agency.
(2) No civil or criminal proceedings may be taken, in relation to the action,
against either or both of the officer, employee, or agent, and the financial
institution, Government department, or statutory body.
(3) Nothing in this section prevents proceedings to enforce compliance with
a direction under section 25.

29 Immunity

No action lies against any of the following for anything done in good faith
in the exercise or performance, or purported exercise or performance, of
any function, power, or duty under this Act –
(a) The Attorney-General;
(b) The head or any member of the Unit;
(c) Any agent or employee of the Unit;
(d) Any person acting at the direction of the head of the Unit.
PART 6
CURRENCY REPORTING AT THE BORDER

30 Certain cash and instruments to be reported

(1) An individual who arrives in, or is leaving, Niue with more than the
prescribed sum in cash or negotiable bearer instruments (as defined in section
31(1)) on his or her person, or in his or her luggage, must make or cause to be
made to a Customs officer a report that complies with subsection (3) and, if the
individual fails to do so, he or she is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction
by a fine of not more than 20 penalty units.
(2) Until another sum is prescribed instead, the prescribed sum is $10, 000.
(3) A report complies with this subsection if it –
(a) Is in writing and in the prescribed form or, if no form is prescribed,
in a form approved by the Customs officer; and
(b) Contains the following details in relation to the cash or negotiable
bearer instruments to which the report relates –
(i) the nature and amount of each type of cash or negotiable bearer
instrument; and
(ii) the total amount of the cash or negotiable bearer instruments;
and
(c) Is made by the individual himself or herself (or, if he or she is, by
reason of age or disability, incapable of complying with the
requirements of this section, by a parent or guardian or other perso
for the time being having the care of the individual, and on the
individual’s behalf); and
(d) Is signed by the person who made the report or, as the case requires,
on whose behalf the report is made; and
(e) Is given to the Customs officer before the cash or negotiable bearer
instruments leave the control of the Customs.

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

853
(4) It is a defence to a charge under this section against a person in relation to a failure to make or cause to be made a report to a Customs officer before cash or a negotiable bearer instrument leaves the control of the Customs if the defendant proves —
(a) That the failure was due to some emergency or to any other circumstance outside the reasonable control of the defendant; and
(b) That the defendant made or caused to be made a report in respect of that cash or negotiable bearer instrument as soon as practicable after the obligation to make the report arose.

31 Powers of search

(1) In this section and sections 32 to 35 —
“authorised officer” means —
(a) A police officer; or
(b) A Customs officer; or
(c) A member of the Unit;
“negotiable bearer instrument”, without limiting the definition of the term
“cash” in section 2(1) –
(a) Means a document representing ownership of debts or obligations;
and
(b) Includes a bill of exchange, promissory note, or certificate of deposit,
whether made payable to the bearer or not.
(2) Subsections (3) and (4) apply to a person who—
(a) Is about to leave, or has arrived in, Niue; or
(b) Is about to board or leave, or has boarded or left, a ship or aircraft
that is about to leave, or has arrived in, Niue.
(3) An authorised officer may detain a person to whom this subsection
applies and examine an article that the person has with him or her, or in his or her
luggage, for the purpose of determining whether the person has in his or her
possession cash or negotiable bearer instruments in respect of which a report under
section 30 is required.
(4) An authorised officer may detain and search a person to whom this
subsection applies if the authorised officer suspects on reasonable grounds that
an offence against section 30 is being, or may have been, committed by the person.

32 Further provisions on search

(1) Reasonable force may be used if it is necessary to effect a detention, or
examination, or search under section 31 (3) or (4).
(2) An authorised officer may exercise a power under section 31(3) or (4)
with any assistance that may be reasonable and necessary.
(3) A person may be searched under section 31(4) only by a person of the
same sex, and no search under section 31 (4) may be carried out in the view of a
person who is not of the same sex as the person to be searched.
(4) Every search under section 31(4) must be conducted with decency and
sensitivity and in a manner that affords to the person being searched the greatest
degree of privacy and dignity consistent with the purpose of the search.
(5) An authorised officer, and any person assisting that officer, may stop,
board, and search a ship, aircraft, or conveyance for the purposes of exercising the
powers conferred by section 31 (3) or (4).
854 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

33 Seizure of cash or instruments

(1) An authorised officer may seize and, in accordance with section 34,
detain cash or negotiable bearer instruments found in the course of an examination
or search under section 31 (3) or (4) if the officer believes, on reasonable grounds,
that the cash or negotiable bearer instruments may be evidence of the commission
of –
(a) A money laundering offence; or
(b) Financing of terrorism; or
(c) An offence under section 30 of this Act; or
(d) A serious offence.
(2) An authorised officer who seizes cash or a negotiable bearer instrument
under subsection (1) must report the seizure to the Unit.
(3) An authorised officer may seize and, in accordance with section 34,
detain cash or a negotiable bearer instrument that is being (in any form or manner)
imported into, or exported from, Niue if the cash or negotiable bearer instrument
comes to the attention, or into the possession, of the authorised officer in the exercise
or performance of his or her official powers, functions, or duties, and he or she
has reasonable grounds for suspecting that it is derived from, or intended by a
person for use in the commission of –
(a) A money laundering offence; or
(b) Financing of terrorism; or
(c) A serious offence.

34 Detention of cash or instruments seized

(1) Cash or a negotiable bearer instrument seized under section 33 must
not be detained by the authorised officer for longer than 48 hours after seizure,
unless the High Court makes an order of continued detention for a period not
exceeding 3 months from the date of seizure.
(2) The Court may make an order of continued detention under subsection
(1) only if satisfied on a written application for the purpose –
(a) That there are reasonable grounds to suspect that the cash or
negotiable bearer instrument was derived from, or is intended by
a person for use in the commission of, an offence of the kind
specified in section 33(3)(a) to (c); and
(b) That the continued detention of the cash or negotiable bearer
instrument is justified while its origin or derivation is further
investigated.
(3) Having made an order of continued detention under subsection (1),
the Court may later (and once only) order, if it has taken all reasonable steps to
notify and hear all parties concerned, and is satisfied of the matters specified in
subsection (2)(a) and (b), the continued detention of the cash or negotiable bearer
instrument.
(4) However, the total period of detention under any later order must not
exceed 2 years from the date of that order.

35 Release of detained cash or instruments

(1) The authorised officer must release cash or a negotiable bearer
instrument detained under section 34, or under an order made under that section,
to the person from whom it was seized or to any other person claiming an interest
in that cash or negotiable bearer instrument if –

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006

855
(a) The High Court orders (on a written application made by, or on behalf of, that person, and after the Court has considered any views of the Unit and the authorised officer to the contrary) that its continued detention is no longer justified; or
(b) The authorised officer is satisfied that its continued detention is no longer justified.
(2) The continued detention of cash or a negotiable bearer instrument detained under section 34 is justified for the purposes of subsection (1) so long as the cash or negotiable bearer instrument is relevant to –
(a) An investigation or prosecution of –
(i) a money laundering offence or any other offence against the
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998; or
(ii) financing of terrorism; or
(iii) a serious offence; or
(b) Any other investigation, or any other proceeding, under the
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998.
PART 7
OTHER MATTERS

36 Opening accounts in false names

A person who opens or operates an account with a financial institution in
a false name is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction by –
(a) In the case of an individual - imprisonment for a term of not more
than 4 years or a fine of not more than 1000 penalty units or both;
or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - a fine of not more than 5000 penalty
units.

37 Anonymous accounts prohibited

(1) A financial institution must not open, operate, or maintain an
anonymous account or an account in a false name.
(2) If a financial institution contravenes subsection (1), the financial
institution is guilty of an offence punishable on conviction by:
(a) In the case of an individual - imprisonment for a term of not more
than 4 years or a fine of not more than 1000 penalty units or both;
or
(b) In the case of a body corporate - a fine of not more than 5000 penalty
units.
(3) However, a financial institution does not contravene subsection (1) just
because the financial institution operates, on or after the commencement of this
Act and in what appears to the financial institution to be the account holder ’s true
name, an account that –
(a) Existed on the commencement of this Act; and
(b) Was at that time an anonymous account.

38 Alternative remittance

(1) For the purposes of this section a “funds or assets transfer system” is
one that consists of a financial service that accepts cash, cheques or any other
instrument of payment or stores of value at a given location and pays an equal
amount in cash or in any other form to a beneficiary located in another geographical
area by means of a method of communication, a message, transfer, compensation
or clearing system to which the funds or assets transfer system belongs.
856 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) A person who is not a financial institution and who, on behalf of, or in the name of, another person operates a funds or assets transfer system as a principal or essential part of his or her activities must be authorized to do so by the relevant supervisory authority.
(3) A person who operates a funds or assets transfer system is subject to Parts 2 and 3 and any other requirements prescribed by the relevant supervisory authority.
(4) A person commits an offence who operates a funds or assets transfer system in contravention of this section and is liable on conviction –
(a) In the case of a natural person, to a fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units or a term of imprisonment not exceeding 5 years; and
(b) In the case of a body corporate, to a maximum fine of 10,000 penalty
units.

39 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as are necessary or convenient for the
purposes of this Act.

40 [Spent]

SCHEDULE

[Section 8(3)]

DETAILS THAT MUST BE INCLUDED IN SUSPICIOUS TRANSACTION REPORTS

1 The name and address of the financial institution, including the branch of the institution (if applicable) at which the transaction was conducted.

2 The nature of the transaction.

3 The date of the transaction.

4 The total amount involved in the transaction.

5 The type of currency involved in the transaction, and its equivalent in the local currency.

6 For each person conducting the transaction with the financial institution: (a) The name of the person; and

(b) The business or residential address of the person; and

(c) The occupation, business, or principal activity of the person; and

(d) The nationality and date and place of birth of the person; and

(e) In the case of a natural person, details of the person’s current passport,

official government identification or driving licence; and

(f) In the case of a body corporate, details of its Constitution (if it is not older

than 3 months); and

(g) The method used by the financial institution to verify the identity of the

person; and

(h) The place and time of the financial transaction; and

(i) whether the transaction was conducted on behalf of the person or

on behalf of another person.

Financial Transactions Reporting Act 2006 857

7 For any person on whose behalf the transaction was conducted: (a) The name of the person; and

(b) The address of the person; and

(c) The occupation of the person (or, where appropriate, the business or principal activity of the person); and

(d) The nationality and date and place of birth of the person.

858 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

859

FIREWORKS ACT 1958

1958/56 – 5 June 1958

1

Short title

6

Offences and penalties

2

Interpretation

7

Cabinet may impose conditions

3

Construction or manufacture of fireworks

8

Fireworks may be seized

4

Written consent of Cabinet required

9

Fireworks seized

5

Permit to discharge fireworks

10 Offences and penalties

To make provision for the control of the manufacture, importation and use of fireworks

1 Short title

This is the Fireworks Act 1958.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“fireworks” means any explosive and any firework composition enclosed
in any case or contrivance or otherwise manufactured so as to form a
squib, cracker, serpent, rocket (other than a ship safety rocket), maroon,
lance wheel, Chinese fire, Roman candle or other article made or
adapted for the production of pyrotechnic effects and includes sparklers,
matches, and throwdowns;
“import” means to bring or cause to be brought or sent or to introduce in
any other way whatever into Niue.

3 Construction or manufacture of fireworks

No person in Niue shall construct or manufacture any fireworks or produce
fireworks in any manner or by any method whatever whether by making a new
article or adapting any existing article.

4 Written consent of Cabinet required

(1) No person shall import any fireworks without having first obtained
the written consent of Cabinet.
(2) Any officer of Police or Customs may detain and examine the contents
of any imported package in respect whereof a breach of this section is reasonably
suspected and any fireworks found to be imported contrary to this section shall
be seized.

5 Permit to discharge fireworks

(1) No person shall discharge any fireworks in Niue except pursuant to a
permit granted by Cabinet and subject to such terms and conditions in the permit
860 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
as Cabinet imposes having regard to the interests of the public safety and of the safety of any person.
(2) Every person who commits a breach of this section is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

6 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person commits an offence under this Act who discharges any
fireworks in any place with intent to do bodily harm to any person or sends or
delivers to or causes to be received by any person any fireworks.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this section shall be liable
to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or to imprisonment not exceeding 3 months.

7 Cabinet may impose conditions

(1) Any consent or permit granted by Cabinet under this Act may be given
subject to such terms and conditions as Cabinet, in its discretion, may impose.
(2) Cabinet may delegate its functions under this Act to an officer of Police
or Customs and any functions so delegated shall be exercised subject to any general
or specific directions which may be given by Cabinet in that behalf.

8 Fireworks may be seized

Any officer of Police, on being authorised so to do by warrant under the
hand of a Commissioner or Registrar of the Court, may, by force if need be, enter
and search any land or buildings in or upon which he has reasonable cause to
believe that there are any fireworks in respect of which a breach of this Act has
been committed, and any such fireworks found on such land or buildings shall be
seized.

9 Fireworks seized

Any fireworks seized under this Act shall become the property of Her
Majesty free and discharged from all rights, title, estate or interest possessed in
respect of it by any other person and shall be destroyed or otherwise disposed of
as in any case Cabinet may direct.

10 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person commits an offence against this Act who –
(a) Fails to comply with any lawful requirements of Cabinet under this
Act; or
(b) In any manner obstructs an officer of Police or Customs in the lawful
exercise of any power, function, or authority conferred on him by
or under this Act; or
(c) With intent to procure by purchase or otherwise any fireworks
contrary to this Act deceives, or attempts to deceive, any officer in
the performance of his duty under this Act; or
(d) Discharges any fireworks in a public place or so near to it as to
endanger, annoy or frighten any persons; or
(e) Discharges any fireworks in any public place or while so situated
that any property whether movable or immovable is thereby liable
to catch fire.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no
penalty is provided elsewhere than in this section is liable to a fine not exceeding
1 penalty unit.
(3) Every corporate body committing an offence against this Act shall be
liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
861

FOOD CONTROL ACT 1981

1981/70 - 18 December 1981

1

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

Short Title

12

Regulations

PART 4

REGULATIONS

2

Interpretation

PART 2

PART 5

ADMINISTRATION

GENERAL

13

Powers of Inspectors

3

Prohibition against sale of poisonous,

14

Analysis of samples

unwholesome or adulterated food

15

Restriction of appointment of Inspectors

4

Misleading or deceptive labeling

16

Power of the Director to obtain particulars

5

Standards for foods

of certain food ingredients

6

Prohibition against sale of food not of the

7

nature, substance or quality demanded

Sale and preparation of food under

PART 6

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

unsanitary conditions

17

Power of Cabinet

8

Medical examination for persons engaged

18

Prosecution

in the handling of food

19

Offences

20

Certificate of analysis

PART 3

9

IMPORTATION, WARRANTIES AND DEFENCES

Importation

PART 7

SAVINGS

10

Warranties

21

Savings

11

Defences

To protect the public against health hazards in the sale and use of food to supplement the public Health Act 1965

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Food Control Act 1981.

2. Interpretation

In this Act –
“advertisement” includes any representation by any means whatsoever
for the purpose of promoting directly or indirectly the sale or disposal
of any food;
“article” includes –
(a) any food and any labeling or advertising materials in respect; or
(b) anything used for the preparation, preservation, packing or storing
of any food;
862 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“certificate of registration” includes every renewal of it; “Director” means the Director of Health
“engaged in the handling of food” means the handling of food as employer or employee or sole proprietor or in any capacity whatsoever whether for remuneration or not;
“food” means any article manufactured sold or represented for use as food
or drink for human consumption;
“handling of food” means taking part in the manufacture, preparation,
storage, packing, carriage or delivery of food for sale or in the retail of
food;
“Inspector” means any Food Inspector appointed under section 7 of the
Public Health Act 1965;
“unsanitary conditions” means such conditions or circumstances as might
cause contamination of any food with dirt or filth or might render the
same injurious or dangerous to health;
“label” includes any tag, brand, mark, pictorial or other descriptive matter,
written, printed, stenciled, marked, embossed or impressed on, or
attached to or included in, belonging to, or accompanying any food;
“package” includes anything in which any food is wholly or partly placed
or packed and includes any basket, pail, tray or receptacle of any kind
whether open or closed;
“premises” means and includes any premises or buildings or any room or
other part thereof or any place in or on which food is handled;
“preparation” includes manufacture processing and any form of treatment;
“sell” includes to barter or to offer or attempt to sell or receive for sale or
send forward for sale or deliver for sale or cause or suffer or allow to be
sold, offered or exposed for sale and to supply meals at any restaurant,
hotel or boarding-house;
“ship” includes any boat or craft
“vehicle” has the meaning as in section 3 of the Transport Act 1965.
PART 2
GENERAL

3 Prohibition against sale of poisonous, unwholesome or adulterated food

Any person who prepares or sells any food that –
(a) Has in or upon it any substance which is poisonous, harmful or
otherwise injurious to health; or
(b) Consists in whole or in part of any filthy, putrid, rotten, decomposed
or diseased substance or foreign matter, is unwholesome or is
otherwise unfit for human consumption; or
(c) Is adulterated;
commits an offence.

4 Misleading or deceptive labeling

Any person who labels, packages, prepares, sells or advertises any food in
a manner that is false, misleading or deceptive as regards its character, nature,
value, substance, quality, composition, merit or safety, or in contravention of any
regulation made under this Act, commits an offence.

Food Control Act 1981

863

5 Standards for foods

Where a standard has been prescribed by regulation under this Act for any
food, any person who labels, packages, prepares, sells or advertises any food which
does not comply with that standard, in such a manner that it is likely to be mistaken
for food of the prescribed standard, commits an offence.

6 Prohibition against sale of food not of the nature, substance or quality demanded

Any person who sells to the prejudice of the purchaser any food which is not of the nature, substance or quality of the article demanded by the purchaser commits an offence.

7 Sale and preparation of food under unsanitary conditions

Any person who sells, prepares, packages or stores for sale any food under
unsanitary conditions commits an offence.

8 Medical examination for persons engaged in the handling of food

(1) Every person who is engaged in the handling of food shall undergo
such medical examinations as is prescribed by the Director, who shall certify the
suitability or otherwise of that person.
(2) No person shall be engaged in the handling of food unless he has
received a certificate declaring him to be suitable to be so engaged.
(3) Every certificate issued under this section shall be renewable annually.
(4) The costs of any medical examination pursuant to this section shall be
met by the employer of the person to be engaged in the handling of food.

9 Importation

PART 3
IMPORTATION, WARRANTIES AND DEFENCES
(1) Subject to subsection (2), the importation of any article which does not comply with this Act or any regulations made under this Act, is prohibited.
(2) Where an article sought to be imported into Niue would, if sold in
Niue, constitute a contravention of this Act or any regulation made under this
Act, the article may be imported into Niue for the purpose of satisfactorily
relabelling or reconditioning the same so that this Act or the regulations are
complied with and, where such relabelling or reconditioning is not carried out
within 3 months of the importation, such article shall be exported by the importer
within a further period of one month or such other period as Cabinet may direct
and, where it is not so exported, it shall be forfeited and disposed of as the Director
may direct.

10 Warranties

(1) No manufacturer or distributor of, or dealer in, any article shall sell
such article to any vendor unless he gives a warranty in writing in the prescribed
form as to the nature and quality of such article to the vendor specifying that the
article may lawfully be sold under this Act or the regulations.
(2) Any person who contravenes subsection (1) or gives a warranty which
is false commits an offence.
864 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

11 Defences

In any proceedings for an offence under this Act it shall be a sufficient
defence for the defendant to prove –
(a) That he purchased the food from another person who furnished a
written warranty in compliance with section 9, and sold the food in
the same condition the article was in at the time he purchased it;
and
(b) That he could not, with reasonable diligence, have ascertained, that
the sale of the article would be in contravention of this Act or the
regulations;
(c) In relation to an offence concerning the publication of an
advertisement, that he received the advertisement for publication
in the ordinary course of business and had no reason to believe
that an offence would be committed.

12 Regulations

PART 4
REGULATIONS
(1) Cabinet may make regulations for the purposes of this Act.
(2) Without prejudice to the generality of subsection (1), the Cabinet may
make regulations –
(a) Declaring that any food or class of food is adulterated if any
prescribed substance or class of substance is presented in it or has
been added to it or extracted or omitted from it;
(b) In respect of –
(i) the labeling and packing and the offering, exposing and
advertising for sale of food;
(ii) the size, dimension, fill and other specifications of packages of
food;
(iii) the sale or the conditions of sale of any food; and
(iv) the use of any substance as an ingredient in any food, to prevent
the consumer or purchaser of it from being deceived or misled
as to its quality, quantity, character, value, composition, effect,
merit or safety or to prevent injury to the health of the consumer
or purchaser;
(c) Prescribing standards of composition, strength, potency, purity,
quality or other property of any food;
(d) In respect of the importation or exportation of food, in order to
ensure compliance with this Act;
(e) In respect of the method of preparation, preserving, packing, storing,
conveying and testing of any food, in the interests of, or for the
prevention of injury to, the health of the consumer, user or purchaser,
and for the observance of adequate standards of hygiene in the
carrying out of these activities;
(f) In respect of the carriage of goods subject to this Act, including the
licensing of vehicles used in such carriage;
(g) Requiring persons who sell food to maintain such books and records
as Cabinet considers necessary for the proper enforcement and
administration of this Act;
(h) Providing for the analysis or examination of food for the purposes
of this Act or for any other purpose and prescribing methods of
analysis;

Food Control Act 1981

865
(i) Providing for the taking of samples of any articles for the purpose of this Act or for any other purposes;
(j) Exempting any food from all or any of the provisions of the Act and prescribing the conditions of such exemption;
(k) In respect of the premises in which foods are prepared, packaged, stored or sold;
(l) Providing for the registration of premises in which food is prepared; (m) Prescribing anything which is to be or which may be prescribed
under this Act.
(3) (a) Before making any regulations Cabinet shall consult with such
organizations as appear to them to be representative of interests
substantially affected by the regulations.
(b) In cases of urgency they may make regulations without such
consultations.
(4) It shall be an offence for any person to commit any act in contravention
of any regulation made under this section.

13 Powers of Inspectors

PART 5
ADMINISTRATION
(1) An Inspector may, at any reasonable hour for the proper performance of his duty –
(a) Enter any premises where he believes any article to which this Act applies is prepared, preserved, packaged, stored or conveyed, examine any such article and take samples and examine anything that he believes is used or capable of being used for such preparation, preservation, packaging, storing, or conveying;
(b) Stop or search or detain any aircraft, ship or vehicle in which he believes on reasonable grounds that any article subject to this Act is being conveyed and examine any such article and take samples for the purpose of this Act;
(c) Open and examine any receptacle or package which he believes
contains any article to which this Act applies;
(d) Examine any books, documents or other records found in any
premises mentioned in paragraph (a) that he believes contain any
information relevant to the enforcement of this Act with respect to
any article to which this Act applies and make copies or take extracts;
and
(e) Seize and detain for such time as may be necessary any article by
means of or in relation to which he believes this Act or the
regulations has been contravened.
(2) An Inspector acting under this section shall, if so required, produce his
authority.
(3) Any owner, occupier or person in charge of any premises entered by
an inspector under subsection (1) (a), or any person found there, who does not
give to the inspector all reasonable assistance in his power and furnish him with
such information as he may reasonably require, commits an offence.
(4) Any person who obstructs or impedes any inspection in the course of
his duties or prevents or attempts to prevent the execution by the inspector of his
duty under this Act commits an offence.
(5) Any person who knowingly makes any false or misleading statement
either orally or in writing to any inspector engaged in carrying out his duties
under this Act commits an offence.
866 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(6) An Inspector shall release any article seized by him under this Act when he is satisfied that all the provisions of this Act or the regulations with respect to it have been complied with.
(7) Where an Inspector has seized an article under this Act and the owner or the person in whose possession the article was at the time of seizure consents to its destruction, the article may be destroyed or otherwise disposed of as the Inspector may direct; if the owner or the person does not consent to the destruction of the article, the Inspector may apply to the court for the destruction or disposal of such article and the court may make such order as it thinks fit.
(8) Where any article has been seized under subsection (1)(e) and the owner has been convicted of an offence under this Act, the article may be destroyed or otherwise disposed of as the court may direct.
(9) Any person who removes, alters, or interferes in any way with any article seized under this Act without the authority of an Inspector commits an offence.
(10) Any article seized under this Act may at the option of an Inspector be kept or stored in the premises where it was seized or may at the direction of an inspector be removed to any other place.
(11) Any Inspector may submit any article seized by him or any sample from it or any sample taken by him to a laboratory for analysis or examination.

14 Analysis of samples

Any sample taken under this Act shall be analysed or examined as soon as
practicable by a suitably qualified person, and the person carrying out the analysis
or the examination shall give the inspector who took the sample a certificate
specifying the results of the analysis or examination, and such certificate shall be
in such form as may be prescribed by the Director.

15 Restriction on appointment of Inspectors

No person shall be appointed as an Inspector for any area in which he is
engaged directly or indirectly in any trade or business connected with the sale of
food.

16 Power of Director to obtain particulars of certain food ingredients

(1) The Director may direct any person who at the date of the direction or
at any subsequent time carries on a business which includes the production,
importation or use of any substances to which this Act applies to furnish to him
within such time as may be specified in such direction, such particulars, as may
be so specified, of the composition, and use of any such substance sold or for sale
in the course of that business or used in the preparation of food.
(2) Without prejudice to the generality of subsection (1), a direction made
under it may require the following particulars to be furnished in respect of any
substance –
(a) Particulars of the composition and chemical formula of the
substance;
(b) Particulars of the manner in which the substance is used or proposed
to be used in the preparation of food;
(c) Particulars of any investigations carried out by or to the knowledge
of the person carrying on the business in question, for the purpose
of determining whether and to what extent the substance or any
product formed when the substance is used as aforesaid is injurious
to or in any other way affects health;

Food Control Act 1981

867
(d) Particulars of any investigations carried out by or to the knowledge of the person carrying on the business in question, for the purpose of determining the cumulative effect on the health of a person consuming the substance in ordinary quantities.

17 Power of Cabinet

PART 6
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
(1) On the conviction of any person for any offence under this Act, Cabinet may, direct that any licence issued to such person under any regulations made under this Act, be revoked.
(2) Where a person has been convicted of an offence under this Act, the
court may order that any article by means of or in relation to which the offence
was committed or anything of a similar nature belonging to or in the possession
of the convicted person or found with such article, be forfeited, and upon such
order being made such articles and things may be disposed of as the Court may
direct.

18 Prosecution

(1) Where a person having analysed or examined any article to which this
Act applies, has given his certificate and from that certificate it appears that an
offence under this Act has been committed, an Inspector may take proceedings
under this Act before the court.
(2) In any proceedings under this Act, the contents of any package
appearing to be intact and in the original state of packing by the manufacturer
shall be deemed, unless the contrary is proved, to be an article of the description
specified on the label.
(3) In any proceedings taken under this Act, it shall not be necessary to
prove knowledge or intention on the part of the accused.

19 Offences

(1) A person found guilty of an offence under this Act for which no special
penalty is provided shall be liable on conviction –
(a) In the case of a first offence, to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit
or to an imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months, or to
both such fine and imprisonment;
(b) In the case of a subsequent offence, to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty
units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months, or to
both such fine and imprisonment.
(2) If a person found guilty of an offence is found to have committed the
offence with the intent to defraud or mislead he shall be fined a sum not exceeding
5 penalty units or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or both.

20 Certificate of analysis

(1) In any proceedings under this Act –
(a) A certificate or analysis purporting to be signed by a person carrying
out an analysis or examination shall subject to subsection (2) be
accepted as prima facie evidence of the facts stated in it;
(b) Evidence that the package containing any article to which this Act
applies, bore a name, address or registered mark of the person by
whom it was manufactured or packed shall be prima facie evidence
that such article was manufactured or packed by that person;
868 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(c) Any substance commonly used for human consumption if sold or offered, exposed or kept for sale, shall be presumed, until the contrary is proved, to have been sold or to have been or to be intended for sale for human consumption;
(d) Any substance commonly used for human consumption which is found on premises used for the preparation, storage or sale of that substance and any substance commonly used in the manufacture of produces for human consumption which is found on premises used for the preparation, storage or sale of those products, shall be presumed, until the contrary is proved, to be intended for sale, or for manufacturing products for sale, for human consumption;
(e) Any substance capable of being used in the composition or
preparation of any substance commonly used for human
consumption which is found on premises on which that substance
is prepared shall until the contrary is proved, be presumed to be
intended for such use.
(2) (a) The party against whom a certificate or analysis is produced under
subsection (1) may require the attendance of the person performing
the analysis for the purpose of cross-examination; the accused, if
found guilty, will be liable for the costs of the attendance at the
proceedings of the person performing the analysis.
(b) No certificate under subsection (1) of a person carrying out an
analysis or examination shall be received in evidence unless the
party intending to produce it has before the trial given the party
against whom it is intended to be produced reasonable notice of
such intention together with a copy of the certificate.

21 Savings

PART 7
SAVINGS
This Act shall be additional to and not in derogation of any other legislation.
869

FUGITIVE OFFENDERS ACT 1881

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The Fugitive Offenders Act 1881 (UK) which is law for Niue by virtue of section 16 of the Crimes Against Internationally Protected Persons and Hostages Act 1984.

This Act is not reproduced. It will be repealed by the Bill which reforms the laws on extradition.]

870 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

871

GENERAL AGREEMENT ON TARIFFS AND TRADE ACT 1948

[EDITORIAL NOTE: This Act is not reproduced. The text can be found in Niue Legislation as at 1

August 1990 vol 2 p 181.]

872 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

873

GENERAL LAWS ACT 1968

1968/52 – 1 November 1968

1

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

Short title

11

12

13

Public to be duly warned

Effect of closing order

Restricted admittance to closed area

2

14

Offences

3

4

Interpretation

Chief of Police to administer Act

15

Aggravated offences

PART 4

PART 2

OFFENCES INJURIOUS TO PUBLIC MORALITY

5

6

7

8

UNAUTHORISED PERSONS ON BOARD SHIP

Application of Part 2

[Spent]

Disobedience when ordered to leave ship

Arrest without warrant

16

17

18

Adultery by married persons

Adultery with married persons

Scandalous conduct

PART 5

9

Offence of obstructing or resisting

MISCELLANEOUS

10

PART 3

CONTROL OF WHARF

Closing order

19

20

21

[Spent]

Application of fines

Power to make regulations

To make better provision for the order and good government of Niue

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the General Laws Act 1968.

2 –

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Chief of Police” means the Chief of Police in Niue.

4 Chief of Police to administer Act

The Chief of Police shall be charged with the administration of this Act
under the general direction and control of Cabinet.
874 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
PART 2
UNAUTHORISED PERSONS ON BOARD SHIP

5 Application of Part 2

(1) This Part shall apply to every ship calling on Niue from the time of
here arrival in the roadstead until the time of her departure from it.
(2) In this Part, “ship” includes every description of vessel used for overseas
voyages, however propelled, but does not include ships of the naval forces of any
country.

6 [Spent]

7 Disobedience when ordered to leave ship

Every person who not being a person bound or entitled to sail on the ship
or a person duly authorised to be on the ship for any purpose recognised by law)
refuses or fails to leave the ship when ordered so to do by the master or any officer
of the ship or by any officer of Police or Customs or, after having complied with
an order to leave the ship or after being taken ashore, re-enters or attempts to re­
enter the ship commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 0.5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months.

8 Arrest without warrant

The master or any officer of the ship or any officer of Customs may take
ashore or, as circumstances require, take into custody any person who acts in
contravention of section 7 and deliver him to a constable and any constable may
arrest without warrant any person so acting or so delivered to him.

9 Offence of obstructing or resisting

Every person who wilfully obstructs, hinders, or resists any person in the
exercise or execution of any power, duty or function conferred or imposed on
such person by this Part commits an offence and, unless the Niue Act 1966 provides
a more severe penalty in respect of the same offence, shall be liable on conviction
to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

10 Closing order

PART 3
CONTROL OF WHARF
The Chief of Police in concurrence with the Revenue Manager shall have power to close at any time and for any period of time the wharf or any portion of it, or any building, machinery, or other construction erected on or near the wharf (in this Part referred to as the closed area).

11 Public to be duly warned

The Chief of Police shall in such customary and practicable manner as he
deems fit make generally known to the public every order under section 10
specifying the closed area and the hours of commencement and termination of
the order.

12 Effect of closing order

The effect of any order so made shall be that, for the period of time specified
in the order, any closed area shall be deemed not to be open to the public as of
right.

General Laws Act 1968

875

13 Restricted admittance to closed area

(1) Except with the permission of the constable on duty on the wharf, no
person shall enter any closed area unless his presence is required for the working
of the wharf or for the pursuit of any legitimate and customary other work or
business in connection with it.
(2) Any constable may remove from the closed area any person found there
in contravention of this Part.

14 Offences

Every person who acts in contravention of this Part commits an offence
and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

15 Aggravated offences

Every person who, after being ordered or removed from any closed area
re-enters or attempts to re-enter that closed area commits an offence and, unless
the Niue Act 1966 provides a more severe penalty in respect of the same offence,
shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units or to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months.
PART 4
OFFENCES INJURIOUS TO PUBLIC MORALITY

16 Adultery by married persons

Every married person who commits adultery shall be guilty of an offence
and liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

17 Adultery with married person

Every unmarried man who commits adultery with a woman whom he
knows to be married, and every unmarried woman who commits adultery with a
man whom she knows to be married shall be guilty of an offence and liable to a
conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

18 Scandalous conduct

Persons of the opposite sex who, without being married to each other, live together
as husband and wife to the annoyance of the public commit an offence and shall
be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

19 [Spent]

PART 5
MISCELLANEOUS

20 Application of fines

All fines paid or collected under this Act shall form part of the public
revenues of Niue and shall be paid into the appropriate account.

21 Power to make regulations

(1) Cabinet may make regulations –
(a) For the purposes of this Act, and
(b) For the implementation of the International Convention for the
Safety of Life at Sea 1974, the International Shipping and Port
Security Code and any other international standard, requirement
or recommended practice relating to maritime and port security.

876 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(2) Regulations made under this section may make provision for­ (a) Fees and charges, and

(b) Offences and penalties for the contravention of such regulations.

877

GENEVA CONVENTIONS ACT 1958

1958/19 (NZ) – 18 September 1958

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The Schedules to this Act are not reproduced. They provide the texts of:

• Geneva Convention for the Amelioration of the Condition of the Wounded and Sick in Armed

Forces in the Field of August 12, 1949;

• Geneva Convention for the Amelioration of the Condition of Wounded, Sick and Shipwrecked

Members of Armed Forces at Sea of August 12, 1949;

• Geneva Convention Relative to the Treatment of Prisoners of War of August 12, 1949;

• Geneva Convention Relative to the Protection of Civilian Persons in Time of War of August 12,

1949.

Access to these Conventions is available at: http://www.unhchr.ch/html/intlinst.htm and in Niue

Legislation as at 1 August 1990 vol 2 p. 222.]

1

Short title

7

Reduction of sentence, and custody of

2

Interpretation

protected prisoners of war and internees

Punishment of Offenders

Prevention of Abuse of Red Cross and Other

against Conventions

Emblems

3

Punishment for grave breaches of

8

Use of Red Cross and other emblems

Conventions

Miscellaneous

Provisions as to Certain Legal Proceedings

9

Regulations

4

Notice of trial of protected persons to be

10-11

[Spent]

served on protecting power

5

Legal representation of prisoners of war

SCHEDULES

6

Appeals by protected persons

To enable effect to be given to certain International Conventions done at

Geneva on 12 August 1949, and for purposes connected therewith

1 Short title

This is the Geneva Conventions Act 1958.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“the First Convention” means the Geneva Convention for the Amelioration
of the Condition of the Wounded and Sick in Armed Forces in the Field,
adopted at Geneva on 12 August 1949, a copy of which Convention
(not including the annexes to that Convention) is set out in Schedule 1;
“the Second Convention” means the Geneva Convention for the
Amelioration of the Condition of Wounded, Sick, and Shipwrecked
Members of Armed Forces at Sea, adopted at Geneva on 12 August
1949, a copy of which Convention (not including the annex to that
Convention) is set out in Schedule 2;
878

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

“the Third Convention” means the Geneva Convention relative to the Treatment of Prisoners of War adopted at Geneva on 12 August 1949, a copy of which Convention (not including the annexes to that Convention) is set out in Schedule 3;
“the Fourth Convention” means the Geneva Convention relative to the
Protection of Civilian Persons in Time of War, adopted at Geneva on 12
August 1949, a copy of which Convention (not including the annexes
to that Convention) is set out in Schedule 4;
“Conventions” means the First Convention, the Second Convention, the
Third Convention, and the Fourth Convention;
“Court” does not include a Court Martial;
“Niue aircraft” means any aircraft that is registered or required to be
registered in Niue and includes any aircraft belonging to or in the service
of Her Majesty in right of Niue, whether a civil or a military aircraft;
“Niue ship” means a “Niue ship” or “ship belonging to Her Majesty” and
includes an unregistered ship which required by the law of Niue to be
registered in Niue or in some other Commonwealth country;
“protected internee” means a person protected by the Fourth Convention
and interned in Niue;
“protected prisoner of war” means a person protected by the Third
Convention;
“protecting power”, in relation to a protected prisoner of war or a protected
internee, means the power or organisation which is carrying out, in the
interests of the power of which he is a national, or of whose forces he is,
or was at any material time, a member, the duties assigned to protecting
powers under the Third Convention or the Fourth Convention, as the
case may be.
(2) If the ratification on behalf of Niue of any of the Conventions is subject
to a reservation or is accompanied by a declaration, that Convention shall, for the
purposes of this Act, have effect and be construed subject to and in accordance
with that reservation or declaration.

Punishment of Offenders Against Conventions

3 Punishment for grave breaches of Conventions

(1) Any person who in Niue or elsewhere commits, or aids or abets or
procures the commission by another person of, a grave breach of any of the
Conventions is guilty of an offence.
(2) For the purposes of this section –
(a) A grave breach of the First Convention is a breach of that Convention
involving an act referred to in article 50 of that Convention
committed against persons or property protected by that
Convention;
(b) A grave breach of the Second Convention is a breach of that
Convention involving an act referred to in article 51 of that
Convention committed against persons or property protected by
that Convention;
(c) A grave breach of the Third Convention is a breach of that
Convention involving an act referred to in article 130 of that
Convention committed against persons or property protected by
that Convention;

Geneva Conventions Act 1958

879
(d) A grave breach of the Fourth Convention is a breach of that Convention involving an act referred to in article 147 of that Convention committed against persons or property protected by that Convention.
(3) This section applies to persons regardless of their nationality or citizenship.
(4) The punishment for an offence against this section shall be –
(a) Where the offence involves the wilful killing of a person protected
by the relevant Convention, the same as that for the time being for
murder;
(b) In any other cases, imprisonment for a term not exceeding 14 years.
(5) No one shall be prosecuted for an offence under this section without
the leave of Cabinet.
(6) The provisions of section 5 (other than subsection (2)) shall apply in
relation to the trial of a person who is not a protected prisoner of war for an offence
against this section in like manner as they apply in relation to the trial of a protected
prisoner of war.
(7) If in proceedings under this section in respect of a grave breach of any
of the Conventions any question arises under article 2 of that Convention (which
relates to the circumstances in which the Convention applies), that question shall
be determined by the Minister of Foreign Affairs and a certificate purporting to
set out any such determination and to be signed by or on behalf of that Minister
shall be received in evidence and be deemed to be so signed without further proof,
unless the contrary is shown.
(8) The enactments relating to the trial by Court Martial of persons who
commit civil offences shall have effect for the purposes of the jurisdiction of Court
Martial convened in Niue as if this section had not been passed.

Provisions as to Certain Legal Proceedings

4 Notice of trial of protected persons to be served on protecting power

(1) The court before which –
(a) A protected prisoner of war is brought up for trial for any offence;
or
(b) A protected internee is brought up for trial for an offence for which
that court has power to sentence him to death or to imprisonment
for a term of 2 years or more –
shall not proceed with the trial until it is proved to the satisfaction of the court that a notice containing the particulars mentioned in subsection (2), so far as they are known to the prosecutor, has been served not less than 3 weeks previously on the protecting power (if there is a protecting power), on the accused, and (if the accused is a protected prisoner of war) on the prisoners’ representative.
(2) The particulars referred to in subsection (1) are –
(a) The full name and description of the accused, including the date of
his birth and his profession or trade, if any, and, if the accused is a
protected prisoner of war, his rank and his army, regimental,
personal, or serial number;
(b) His place of detention, internment, or residence;
(c) The offence with which he is charged; and
(d) The court before which the trial is to take place and the time and
place appointed for the trial.
880

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(3) For the purposes of this section a document purporting –
(a) To be signed on behalf of the protecting power or by the prisoners’
representative or by the person accused, as the case may be; and
(b) To be an acknowledgement of the receipt by that power,
representative or person on a specified day of a notice described in
it as a notice under this section –
shall, unless the contrary is shown, be sufficient evidence that the notice required
by subsection (1) was served on that power, representative, or person on that day.
(4) In this section “prisoners’ representative” in relation to a particular
protected prisoner of war at a particular time means the person by whom the
functions of prisoners’ representative within the meaning of article 79 of the Third
Convention were exercisable in relation to that prisoner at the camp or place at
which that prisoner was, at or last before that time, detained as a protected prisoner
of war.
(5) Any court which adjourns a trial for the purpose of enabling the requirements of this section to be complied with may, notwithstanding anything in any other enactment or any rule of law, remand the accused for the period of the adjournment.

5 Legal representation of prisoners of war

(1) The court before which a protected prisoner of war is brought up for
trial for any offence shall not proceed with the trial, unless – (a) The accused is represented by counsel; and
(b) It is proved to the satisfaction of the court that a period of not less
than 14 days has elapsed since instructions for the representation
of the accused at the trial were first given to counsel for the accused;
and if the court adjourns the trial for the purpose of enabling the requirements of
this subsection to be complied with, then, notwithstanding anything in any other
enactment or rule of law, the court may remand the accused for the period of the
adjournment.
(2) In the absence of counsel accepted by the accused as representing him,
counsel instructed for the purpose on behalf of the protecting power shall, without
prejudice to the requirements of subsection (1)(b) be regarded for the purposes of
that subsection as representing the accused.
(3) If the court adjourns the trial under subsection (1) by reason that the
accused is not represented by counsel, the court shall direct that a counsel be
assigned to watch over the interests of the accused at any further proceedings, in
the absence of counsel either accepted by the accused as representing him or
instructed as mentioned in subsection (2), counsel assigned under this subsection
shall, without prejudice to the requirements of subsection (1)(b) be regarded for
the purposes of the said subsection (1) as representing the accused.
(4) (a) A counsel shall be assigned under subsection (3) in such manner as
may be prescribed by regulations made under this Act, and any
counsel so assigned shall be entitled to receive, out of money
appropriated by the Assembly for the purpose, such remuneration
and disbursements as may be in like manner prescribed.
(b) While there are no regulations for the purposes of this section or so
far as any such regulations do not apply, the Offenders Legal Aid
Act 1954 (NZ) and of any regulations made under that Act shall
apply to the assignment, remuneration, and disbursement of
counsel under this section.

Geneva Conventions Act 1958

881

6 Appeals by protected persons

(1) Where a protected prisoner of war or a protected internee has been
sentenced by a court to death or to imprisonment for a term of 2 years or more,
the time allowed in relation to the institution of an appeal or an application for
leave to appeal against the conviction or sentence shall, notwithstanding anything
to the contrary in any other enactment, be the period from the date of his conviction
or, in the case of an appeal against sentence, of his sentence to the expiration of 28
days after the date on which the convicted person receives a notice that the
protecting power has been notified of his conviction and sentence, being a notice
given –
(a) In the case of a protected prisoner of war, by an officer of the New
Zealand armed forces; or
(b) In the case of a protected internee, by or on behalf of the person in
charge of the prison or place in which he is confined.
(2) [Repealed 1971/208/53 (NZ)]
(3) Where subsection (1) applies in relation to a convicted person, then,
unless the Court otherwise orders, an order of the Court relating to the restitution
of property or the payment of compensation to an aggrieved person shall not take
effect, and any provision of law relating to the revesting of property on conviction
shall not take effect in relation to the conviction, while an appeal by the convicted
person against his conviction or sentence is possible.
(4) Subsections (1) and (2) shall not apply in relation to an appeal against a
conviction or sentence if, at the time of the conviction or sentence, there is no
protecting power.
(5) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any other Act, where a
protected prisoner of war has been sentenced by a court to death, the sentence
shall not be executed before the expiration of 6 months from the date specified in
article 101 of the Third Convention.
(6) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any other act, where a
protected internee has been sentenced by a court to death, the sentence shall not
be executed before the expiration of 6 months from the date specified in article 74
of the Fourth Convention.

7 Reduction of sentence, and custody of protected prisoners of war and internees

(1) When a protected prisoner of war or a protected internee is convicted of an offence, the court shall –
(a) In fixing a term of imprisonment in respect of the offence, deduct from the term which it would otherwise have fixed any period during which the convicted person has been in custody in connection with that offence before the trial; and
(b) In fixing any penalty other than imprisonment in respect of the offence, take that period of custody into account.
(2) Where the Minister of Justice is satisfied that a protected prisoner of
war accused of an offence has been in custody in connection with that offence,
while awaiting trial, in a place other than a camp or place in which protected
prisoners of war are detained, for an aggregate period of not less than 3 months,
that Minister may direct that the prisoner shall be transferred from that custody
to the custody of an officer of the New Zealand armed forces and thereafter remain
in military custody at a camp or place in which protected prisoners of war are
detained, and be brought before the court at the time appointed for his trial.
882

8

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Prevention of Abuse of Red Cross and Other Emblems

Use of Red Cross and other emblems

(1) Subject to this section, it shall not be lawful for any person, without the
authority of the Minister of Defence or a person authorised by him in writing to give consent under this section, to use for any purpose whatsoever any of the following emblems, designations, designs, or wordings:
(a) The emblem of a red cross with vertical and horizontal arms of the same length on, and completely surrounded by, a white ground, or the designation “Red Cross” or “Geneva Cross”;
(b) The emblem of a red crescent moon on, and completely surrounded by, a white ground, or the designation “Red Crescent”;
(c) The following emblem in red on, and completely surrounded by, a
white ground, that is to say, a lion passing from right to left of, and
with its face turned towards, the observer, holding erect in its raised
right forepaw a scimitar, with, appearing above the lion’s back, the
upper half of the sun shooting forth rays, or the designation “Red
Lion and Sun”;
(d) Any design consisting of a white or silver cross with vertical and
horizontal arms of the same length on, and completely surrounded
by, a red ground, being the heraldic emblem of the Swiss
Confederation, or any other design so nearly resembling that design
as to be capable of being mistaken for that heraldic emblem;
(e) Any design or wording so nearly resembling any of the emblems
or designations specified in the foregoing provisions of this
subsection as to be capable of being mistaken for, or, as the case
may be, understood as referring to, one of those emblems.
(2) If any person contravenes the foregoing provisions of this section he
shall be guilty of an offence and be liable on summary conviction to a fine not
exceeding 1 penalty unit and to forfeit any goods upon or in connection with
which the emblem, designation, design, or wording was used.
(3) The Minister of Defence or a person authorised by that Minister to give
consents under this section shall not refuse to give such a consent, and shall not
withdraw such a consent, except for the purpose of giving effect to the provisions
of the Conventions.
(4) In the case of a trade mark registered before the passing of this Act, the
foregoing provisions of this section shall not apply by reason only of its consisting
of or containing a design or wording which reproduces or resembles an emblem
or designation specified in subsection (1)(b) or (c).
(5) Where a person is charged with using a design or wording to which
subsection (4) applies for any purpose and it is proved that he used it otherwise
than as, or as part of, a trade mark registered as aforesaid, it shall be a defence for
him to prove –
(a) That he lawfully used that design or wording for that purpose before
the passing of this Act; or
(b) In a case where he is charged with using the design or wording
upon goods, that the design or wording had been applied to the
goods before he acquired them by some other person who had
manufactured or dealt with the goods in the course of trade and
who lawfully used the design or wording upon similar goods before
the passing of this Act.

Geneva Conventions Act 1958

883
(6) Where an offence under this section committed by a body corporate is proved to have been committed with the consent or connivance of any director, manager, secretary or other officer of the body corporate, or any person purporting to act in any such capacity he, as well as the body corporate, shall be deemed to be guilty of the offence and shall be liable to be proceeded against and punished accordingly.
(7) This section extends to the use in or outside Niue of an emblem, designation, design, or wording referred to in subsection (1) on any Niue ship or Niue aircraft.
(8) No one shall be prosecuted for an offence under this section without the leave of Cabinet.

9 Regulations

Miscellaneous

(1) The Governor-General, may by Order in Council, make all such regulations as may be necessary or expedient for giving full effect to this Act and for the due administration of it.
(2) All regulations made under this section shall be laid before Parliament
within 28 days after the date of the making of it if Parliament is then in session
and, if not, shall be laid before Parliament within 28 days after the date of the
commencement of the next ensuing session.

10-11 [Spent]

–––––––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULES
[Not reproduced]

884 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

885

GOVERNMENT LOANS ACT 1980

1980/56 – 25 June 1980

1

Short title

13

Niue stock

2

Interpretation

14

Stock register

3

Authority to raise loans

15

Stock certificates

4

Methods of raising loans

16

Transfer and transmission of stock

5

Charge on Niue Government Account

17

Stock holders of unclaimed interests

6

Issue of debentures

18

Closing of register

7

Redemption of debentures

19

Interest and payment

8

Interest on debentures

20

Redemption of stock

9

Form of debentures and coupons

21

Withdrawal from Niue Government

10

Transfer of debentures and coupons

Account

11

Register of debentures

22

Sinking fund

12

Redeemed debentures

To make provision for the raising of loans both locally and overseas by the Government

1 Short title

This is the Government Loans Act 1980.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“debenture” means any debenture issued under this Act;
“loans” means loans raised under this Act;
“register” includes any book kept by any registering authority under this
Act;
“registering authority” means the Treasury;
“stock” means stock issued under this Act and includes any share or interest
in such stock;
“stockholder” means any person holding stock and entered as proprietor
of it in the register.

3 Authority to raise loans

(1) Cabinet is hereby empowered, subject to this Act, to raise internally or
externally loans of such sums of money as the Assembly may authorise by
resolution.
(2) All moneys borrowed under the authority of this Act shall be applied
for such purposes as shall be specified by the resolution authorising the borrowing
of such moneys.
886 Niue Laws 2005 Vol 1

4 Methods of raising loans

Loans may be raised under this Act –
(a) By the issue of securities in the form of debentures payable to bearer;
or
(b) By the creation and issue of registered or inscribed stock which
shall be known as Niue stock; or
(c) In such other manner as Cabinet may, in consultation with any
lender, decide.

5 Charge on Niue Government Account

The principal moneys and interest represented by loans issued under this
Act are hereby charged upon and shall be payable out of the Niue Government
Account.

6 Issue of debentures

(1) Where Cabinet deems it expedient to raise money by debentures, such
debentures may be issued by the Treasury on behalf of the Government upon the
best and most favourable terms that can be obtained, and to such amounts and on
such conditions, subject to this Act, as Cabinet may direct.
(2) Debentures shall be of such denominations as the Cabinet may
determine.

7 Redemption of debentures

Debentures shall be redeemable either –
(a) At par on a fixed date to be declared on the issue of the debentures:
Provided that Cabinet may reserve the option to redeem the
debentures prior to such date on such conditions as may be declared
at the time of issue; or
(b) By annual drawings at par; or
(c) At the option of Cabinet by purchase.

8 Interest on debentures

(1) The interest upon the principal represented by each debenture shall
run from the date of issue named in that behalf in the debenture, and shall be
paid half-yearly on the dates named in that behalf in the debenture.
(2) (a)There shall be attached to every debenture coupons for the payment
of interest to become due in each half year upon the principal
represented by the debenture.
(b) The coupons shall be sufficient in number to provide for the
payment of interest either during the whole period for which the
debenture has to run or for such limited period as Cabinet may
determine.

9 Form of debentures and coupons

The debentures and coupons shall be in such form as Cabinet may direct.

10 Transfer of debentures and coupons

Every debenture and coupon, and the right to receive the principal and
interest represented by it shall be transferable by delivery.

11 Register of debentures

Every debenture shall, before being issued, be registered in a register book
to be kept for that purpose by the Treasury.

Government Loans Act 1980

887

12 Redeemed debentures

(1) Upon the repayment of the principal moneys secured by any debenture,
the debenture shall, and on the redemption by purchase of any debenture the
debenture may, together in either case with all outstanding coupons, be delivered
up to the issuing authority for cancellation.
(2) Debentures redeemed by purchase which are not delivered up for
cancellation shall be deemed part of the sinking fund and may in all respects be
dealt with as such.

13 Niue stock

Niue stock may be issued in Niue or elsewhere, upon the directions of
Cabinet upon the best and most favourable terms that can be obtained, and to
such amounts and on such conditions, subject to this Act, as Cabinet may before
the issue direct.

14 Stock register

(1) A register shall be kept in which –
(a) All stock issues under this Act shall be registered, or, in the case of
inscribed stock, inscribed;
(b) All transfers, transmissions and other dealings in such stock under
this Act shall be registered; and
(c) All other matters and things which by this Act are required to be
entered therein shall be entered.
(2) Issues of inscribed stock shall be inscribed in the register by entering
the name of the stock holder, the amount of such stock and such other particulars
as may be prescribed.
(3) The register shall be prima facie evidence of title of any person in respect
of any stock of which he is entered as the stockholder.
(4) The register shall be kept by the Treasury.

15 Stock certificates

(1) (a) The registering authority shall within 30 days of receipt of the final
instalment payable on any stock send to the stockholder a certificate,
which shall be known as a stock certificate, showing that stock to
the value specified in it has been registered or inscribed in the name
of the stockholder.
(b) In the case of inscribed stock a stock certificate need not be issued
unless demanded by the stockholder.
(2) (a) Such stock certificate shall be prima facie evidence of the title of the
stockholder to the stock specified in it.
(b) In the case of inscribed stock the want of such certificate shall not
prevent the owner of any stock from disposing of it.

16 Transfer and transmission of stock

(1) Stock shall be transferable by an instrument of transfer to be approved
by Cabinet, and a certificate issued, at the request of the transferee, by the
registering authority in pursuance of such transfer and in respect of the stock so
transferred shall be prima facie evidence of the title of the holder of the certificate
to the stock specified.
(2) Any person to whom any stock is transmitted may apply in such form
as may be approved by the Cabinet to the registering authority by which the register
in which such stock is registered or inscribed to be registered as the proprietor of
such stock.
888 Niue Laws 2005 Vol 1
(3) Every transmission application shall be verified by statutory declaration or in such other manner as may be approved by Cabinet and shall be supported by the production to the registering authority of the original or certified true copies of all documents under which the applicant claims to be entitled to be registered as the proprietor of the stock.
(4) If the registering authority is satisfied that a person applying under
subsection (2) to be registered as the proprietor of any stock, is entitled so to be
registered, it shall register such transmission by entering the name of such person
in the register as the proprietor of such stock.
(5) No person shall have any claims against the Government in respect of
any transmission registered under subsection (4) but nothing in this subsection
shall relieve the person to whom the stock is transmitted from any liability to
account for or deal with the stock in accordance with law.

17 Stock holders of unclaimed interests

The registering authority shall keep, in a separate book, a list of the stock
holders on whose stock the interest has been unclaimed for 5 years, together with
their registered addresses, and such list shall be open for inspection without
payment of a fee.

18 Closing of register

(1) (a) The registering authority may, for a period not exceeding 14 days
prior to each payment of interest on any stock registered or inscribed
under this Act, close the register of that stock as regards transfer
upon giving not less than 7 days notice of such closing.
(b) Such notice shall be published in the Gazette in the case of stock
issued in Niue and in a newspaper circulating in the country
concerned in the case of other stock.
(2) The persons who on the day of such closing are registered as
stockholders shall, as between them and their transferees, be entitled to the interest
then next payable on the stock.

19 Interest and payment

Interest shall be payable on stock half-yearly by the registering authority,
at the rate fixed by Cabinet at the time of the issue of such stock.

20 Redemption of stock

(1) (a) Stock shall be redeemable at par on a date to be named in that behalf
by Cabinet or the registering authority when issuing the stock.
(b) Cabinet or the registering authority may reserve the option to
redeem the stock in whole or in part, by drawings or otherwise at
any time prior to such date on such conditions as may be declared
at the date of issue.
(2) From and after the date appointed for the redemption of the stock or
any part of it all the interest on the principal moneys secured thereby shall cease
and determine, whether payment of the principal shall have been demanded or
not.

Government Loans Act 1980

889

21 Withdrawal from Niue Government Account

So long as any portion of any loan remains outstanding, Cabinet shall in
each half-year withdraw from the Niue Government Account a sum equal to one-
half year ’s interest on the whole of that loan outstanding, and shall authorise the
payment out of such sum of the then current half-year ’s interest on the date on
which it falls due.

22 Sinking fund

(1) (a) Cabinet shall in each half-year ending with the day on which the
interest on any loan falls due withdraw from the Niue Government
Account for formation of a sinking fund for repayment of that loan
at par a sum equal to one-half of the annual contribution specified
in the prospectus, or in the case of a loan not issued publicly, in the
terms of issue relating to the loan.
(b) The said contribution shall in respect of any money raised under
this Act commence not later than 3 years after the date from which
the interest on such money shall commence to run.
(2) The amounts withdrawn from the Niue Government Account under
subsection (1), less any amounts utilised under subsection (5), shall be invested in
investments approved by the Cabinet and, if invested in Niue, shall be invested in
any one or more of the following –
(a) On deposit with the Niue Post Office;
(b) On deposit in any savings bank outside Niue; and
(c) In any security issued by the Government or by any statutory
organisation in Niue.
(3) All investments made under subsection (2) shall be retained as a sinking
fund for the final extinction of any loan for which the sinking fund has been formed
and any dividends, interest or produce of or arising out of or in consequence of
any such investments may be invested in any similar manner to that authorised
by subsection (2) and any such investment may at any time with the approval of
Cabinet be changed to any other investment authorised by subsection (2).
(4) In case the sinking fund provided for by this section shall be insufficient
for the payment of all the principal moneys borrowed under the authority of this
Act in respect of any particular loan at the time the same shall have become due
Cabinet shall make good the deficiency out of the Niue Government Account or
by a loan authorised by section 3.
(5) Cabinet may authorise the utilisation of any amount withdrawn from
the Niue Government account for contribution to the sinking fund prescribed by
subsection (1) for the purchase of debentures or Niue stock for which the sinking
fund has been established.
(6) Cabinet may authorise the utilisation of the whole or any part of the
sinking fund for the repayment in part or in whole of any loan for which the
sinking fund has been established, whether or not such loan has become due for
repayment.

890 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

891

GUARDIANSHIP ACT 1968

1968/63 (NZ) – 1 January 1970

1

Short title

Variation and Enforcement of Orders

2

Interpretation

17

Variation or discharge of orders

3

Definition of custody and guardianship

18

Effect of custody agreements

19

Enforcement of custody and access rights

Jurisdiction

20

Preventing removal of child from Niue

4

[Repealed]

5

Personal jurisdiction

Marriage of Child

21

Termination of guardianship

Natural Guardianship

22

Domicile of married minor

6

Guardianship of children

6A

Declaration as to guardianship of father

Miscellaneous Provisions

23

Welfare of child paramount

Appointment and Removal of Guardians

24

Custody of children over 16

7

Testamentary guardians

25

Consents to operations

8

Court-appointed guardians

26

[Repealed]

9

Wards of Court

27

Procedure and costs

10

Removal of guardian

28

Evidence

11

Custody orders

29

[Repealed]

12

Orders in other proceedings

30

Solicitor or counsel may be appointed

31

Appeals

Disputes

32

Regulations

13

Disputes between guardians

33

Act to be code

14

Review of guardian’s decision or refusal

34

[Repealed]

to give consent

35-38 [Spent]

Access

SCHEDULE

15

Access rights

16

Access of other relatives on death of

parent

To define and regulate the authority of parents as guardians of their children, their power to appoint guardians, and the powers of the courts in relation to the custody and guardianship of children

1 Short title

This is the Guardianship Act 1968.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“child” means a person under the age of 20 years;
“near relative” means a step-parent, grandparent, aunt, uncle, brother, or
sister; and includes a brother or sister of the half-blood as well as of the
full-blood;
“upbringing” includes education and religion.
892 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

3 Definition of custody and guardianship

For the purposes of this Act –
“custody” means the right to possession and care of a child;
“guardianship” means the custody of a child (except in the case of a
testamentary guardian and subject to any custody order made by the
Court) and the right of control over the upbringing of a child, and
includes all rights, powers, and duties in respect of the person and
upbringing of a child that were at the commencement of this Act vested
by any enactment or rule of law in the sole guardian of a child.

4 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Jurisdiction

5 Personal jurisdiction

(1) The Court shall have jurisdiction under this Act –
(a) Where any question of custody, guardianship, or access arises as
an ancillary matter in any proceedings in which the Court has
jurisdiction; or
(b) Where the child who is the subject of the application or order is
present in Niue when the application is made; or
(c) Where the child, or any person against whom an order is sought,
or the applicant, is domiciled or resident in Niue when the
application is made.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) the Court may decline to make an order
under this Act if neither the person against whom it is sought nor the child is
resident in Niue and the Court is of the opinion that no useful purpose would be
served by making an order or that in the circumstances the making of an order
would be undesirable.

Natural Guardianship

6 Guardianship of children

(1) Subject to this Act, the father and the mother of a child shall each be a
guardian of the child.
(2) Subject to this Act, the mother of a child shall be the sole guardian of
the child if –
(a) She is not married to the father of the child, and either –
(i) has never been married to the father; or
(ii) her marriage to the father of the child was dissolved before the
child was conceived; and
(b) She and the father of the child were not living together as husband
and wife at the time the child was born.
(3) Where the mother of a child is, or was at the time of her death, its sole
guardian by virtue of subsection (2) the father of the child may apply to the Court
to be appointed as guardian of the child, either in addition to or instead of the
mother or any guardian appointed by her, and the Court may make such order on
the application as it thinks proper.
(4) On the death of the father or the mother the surviving parent, if he or
she was then a guardian of the child, shall, subject to this Act, be the sole guardian
of the child.

Guardianship Act 1968

893

6A Declaration as to guardianship of father

Any man who alleges that he is a guardian of a child by virtue of section 6
(other than by a virtue of an order under subsection (3)) may apply to the Court
for an order declaring that he is a guardian of the child, and, if it is proved to the
satisfaction of the Court that the allegation is true, and that the man has not been
deprived of his guardianship the Court may make the order.

Appointment and Removal of Guardians

7 Testamentary guardians

(1) The father or the mother of a child (including an unborn child) may by
deed or will appoint any person to be a guardian of the child after his or her
death, and that person is in this Act referred to as a testamentary guardian.
(2) If the person appointing a guardian under subsection (1) is himself a
guardian of the child at his death, the testamentary guardian shall thereupon if he
is of full age and capacity be either sole guardian or a guardian in addition to any
other guardian.
(3) If the person appointing a guardian under subsection (1) is not himself
a guardian at his death, the testamentary guardian may apply to the Court, and
the Court may appoint him as a guardian accordingly.
(4) Notwithstanding any enactment or rule of law, a child may appoint a
guardian by deed or will under subsection (1).

8 Court-appointed guardians

(1) Subject to the provisions of this section, the Court may on application
made for the purpose or on the making of an order under section 10, appoint a
guardian of a child either as sole guardian or in addition to any other guardian,
and either generally or for any particular purpose, and either until the child attains
the age of 20 years or sooner marries, or for any shorter period.
(2) The High Court shall have exclusive jurisdiction to appoint and remove
a guardian ad litem in respect of any proceedings before that or any higher court,
and may appoint or remove a guardian ad litem in respect of any proceedings
before any other court.

9 Wards of Court

(1) The Court may upon application order that any unmarried child be
placed under the guardianship of the Court, and may appoint any person to be
the agent of the Court either generally or for any particular purpose.
(2) An application under subsection (1) may be made –
(a) By a parent, guardian or near relative of the child;
(b) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(c) By the child, who may apply without guardian ad litem or next
friend;
(d) With the leave of the Court, by any other person.
(3) (a) Between the making of the application and its disposal, and after it
if an order is made, the Court shall have the same rights and powers
in respect of the person and property of the child as the Court
possessed immediately before the commencement of this Act in
relation to wards of Court.
(b) The Court shall not direct any child of or over the age of 18 years to
live with any person unless the circumstances are exceptional.
(c) Where any child under the guardianship of the Court marries
without the Court’s consent the Court shall not have the power to
commit that child or his or her spouse for contempt of Court for so
marrying.
894 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(4) A child who has been placed under the guardianship of the Court shall cease to be under such guardianship when the Court so orders or when the child reaches the age of 20 years or sooner marries, whichever first occurs.

10 Removal of guardian

(1) The Court may on application by the other parent or by a guardian or
near relative or, with the leave of the Court, by any other person deprive a parent
of the guardianship of his child or remove from his office any testamentary
guardian or any guardian appointed by the Court.
(2) No parent shall be deprived of the guardianship of his child under
subsection (1) unless the Court is satisfied that the parent is for some grave reason
unfit to be a guardian of the child or is unwilling to exercise the responsibilities of
a guardian.

11 Custody orders

(1) Subject to section 24 the Court may on application by the father or
mother, or a step-parent, or a guardian, of a child or with the leave of the Court by
any other person, make such order with respect to the custody of the child as it
thinks fit.
(2) Any order made under subsection (1) may be made subject to such
conditions as the Court thinks fit.

12 Orders in other proceedings

(1) Subject to section 24, in any proceedings for nullity, separation or divorce
the Court may, before or by or after the principal decree or order, make such order
(whether an interim order or a permanent order) as it thinks just with respect to
the custody and upbringing of any child of the marriage.
(2) In any such case the Court may make a guardianship order vesting the
sole guardianship of the child in one of the parents, or make such other order with
respect to the guardianship of the child as it thinks fit.
(3) An order may be made under subsection (1) or (2) and any such order
may be varied or discharged, notwithstanding that the Court has refused to make
a decree or to give any other relief sought.
(4) Unless the Court makes a guardianship order every person who was a
guardian of the child shall continue to be a guardian of the child.

Disputes

13 Disputes between guardians

(1) When more than one person is a guardian of a child, and they are unable
to agree on any matter concerning the exercise of their guardianship, any of them
may apply to the Court for its direction, and the Court may make such order
relating to the matter as it thinks proper.
(2) Where more than one person has custody of a child, and they are unable
to agree on any matter affecting the welfare of the child, any of them may apply to
the Court for its direction, and the Court may make such order relating to the
matter as it thinks proper.
(3) Where under an order of the Court more than one person is a guardian
or has custody of a child the Court shall have exclusive jurisdiction to settle
disputes.

Guardianship Act 1968

895

14 Review of guardian’s decision or refusal to give consent

A child of or over the age of 16 years who is affected by a decision or by a refusal
of consent by a parent or guardian in an important matter may apply to the Court
which may review the decision or refusal and make such order in respect of the
matter as the Court thinks fit.

15 Access rights

Access

(1) On making any order with respect to the custody of a child the Court may make such order with respect to access to the child by a parent who does not have custody of it under the order as it thinks fit.
(2) A parent who does not have custody of his child may apply to the
Court for an order granting him access to the child, and the Court may make such
order as it thinks fit.
(3) In this section “parent” includes a step-parent, and “child” has a
corresponding meaning.

16 Access of other relatives on death of parent

If a parent of a child has died, the Court may order that the parents of the
deceased parent, or either of them, or any brother or sister of the deceased parent,
or any brother or sister of the child, shall have access to the child at such times and
places as the Court thinks fit.

Variation and Enforcement of Orders

17 Variation or discharge of orders

(1) The Court may vary or discharge any order with respect to the custody
or upbringing of a child, or with respect to access to a child.
(2) (a) The Court may vary or discharge any order vesting the guardianship
of a child in one parent or in any other person or persons.
(b) If any such guardianship order is discharged, and no other
guardianship order is made, guardianship shall vest in the person
(if any) who would be the guardian if the order discharged had not
been made.
(3) An application to vary or discharge any order to which this section
applies may be made by any person affected by the order, or by any person on
behalf of the child who is the subject of the order.
(4) This section does not apply to an interim order or to an adoption order.

18 Effect of custody agreements

An agreement between the father and mother of a child with respect to the
custody or upbringing of or access to the child shall be valid, whether or not either
of the parties is a minor, but shall not be enforced if the Court is of opinion that it
is not for the welfare of the child to give effect to it.

19 Enforcement of custody and access rights

(1) (a) Where any person is entitled to the custody of a child, whether
under this Act or to the order of a court, the Court may on the
application of the person so entitled to custody, issue a warrant
authorising any constable or social worker or any other person
named in the warrant to take possession of the child and to deliver
him to the person entitled to custody.
896

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(b) Where more than one person is entitled to the custody of a child no warrant issued under this subsection shall authorise the removal of the child from the possession of one of those persons and the delivery of him to another of them.
(2) The Court may on the application of the person entitled to access to a child under an order of the Court, issue a warrant authorising any constable or social worker or any other person named in the warrant to take possession of the child and deliver him to the person entitled to access in accordance with the order. (3) The powers conferred on a court by subsections (1) and (2) may be
exercised on the making of the order.
(4) For the purpose of executing any warrant issued under subsection (1)
or (2), any constable or social worker or any other person named in the warrant,
may enter and search any building, aircraft, ship, vehicle, premises, or place, with
or without assistance and by force if necessary.
(5) The constable, social worker or other person executing any such warrant
shall have it with him and shall produce it if required to do so.
(6) Every person who wilfully resists or obstructs any person in the
execution of any such warrant, or who wilfully fails or refuses to afford to any
person engaged in the execution of any such warrant immediate entrance to any
premises or to any part of them, commits an offence and shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 4 penalty units.
(7) Nothing in subsections (1) to (3) shall limit or affect any other power to
enforce a right of custody or access exercisable by any court at the commencement
of this Act.
(8) Where the Court declines to enforce a right of custody or access it may
of its own motion vary or discharge any existing order of custody or access
accordingly.
(9) Subject to section 9(3)(b) in considering an application under subsection
(1) or (2) of this section, or any other application to enforce a right of custody or
access, the Court shall not grant the application contrary to the wishes of the child
if the child is of or over the age of 18 years.

20 Preventing removal of child from Niue

(1) A Judge or the Registrar of the Court who has reason to believe that
any person is about to take a child out of Niue with intent to defeat the claim of any person who has applied for or is about to apply for custody of or access to the child, or to prevent any order of any Court as to custody of or access to the child from being complied with, may issue a warrant directing any constable or social worker to take the child (using such reasonable force as may be necessary) and place it in the care of some suitable person pending the order or further order of the court having jurisdiction in the case.
(2) Any person who without the leave of the Court takes or attempts to take any child out of Niue knowing that proceedings are pending or are about to be commenced under this Act in respect of the child or that an order of any Court conferring custody of or access to the child on any other person is in force or with intent to prevent any order of any Court as to custody of or access to the child from being complied with commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
3 months or to both.
(3) No proceedings for contempt of court shall be taken against any person
in respect of any act to which this section applies.

Guardianship Act 1968

897

Marriage of Child

21 Termination of guardianship

(1) Guardianship of a child shall terminate when the child attains the age
of 20 years or marries under that age.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) shall limit or affect the appointment of a
guardian ad litem or the powers of the Court in respect of any such guardian.

22 Domicile of married minor

The domicile of a minor who is or has been married shall be determined as
if the minor were an adult.

Miscellaneous Provisions

23 Welfare of child paramount

(1) (a) In any proceedings where any matter relating to the custody or
guardianship of or access to a child, or the administration of any
property belonging to or held in trust for a child, or the application
of the income thereof, is in question, the Court shall regard the
welfare of the child as the first and paramount consideration.
(b) The Court shall have regard to the conduct of any parent to the
extent only that such conduct is relevant to the welfare of the child.
(2) In any such proceedings the Court shall ascertain the wishes of the
child, if the child is able to express them, and shall, subject to section 19(9), take
account of them to such extent as the Court thinks fit, having regard to the age
and maturity of the child.
(3) Nothing in this section shall limit sections 64 and 64A of the Trustee
Act 1956.

24 Custody of children over 16

(1) An order with respect to the custody of a child of or over the age of 16
years shall not be made unless there are special circumstances.
(2) An order in respect of a child under the age of 16 years in so far as it
relates to custody shall expire when the child attains that age unless the Court in
special circumstances otherwise orders at the time of making the order or
subsequently.
(3) Nothing in this section shall limit or affect the power of the Court to
make orders in respect of the upbringing of a child, or to appoint or remove
guardians.
(4) Nothing in this section shall apply in respect of children who are under
the guardianship of the Court.

25 Consents to operations

(1) Subject to subsection (6), the consent of a child of or over the age of 16
years to any donation of blood by him, or to any medical, surgical, or dental
procedure (including a blood transfusion) to be carried out on him for his benefit
by a person professionally qualified to carry it out, shall have the same effect as if
he were of full age.
(2) The consent of or refusal to consent by a child to any donation of blood
or to any medical, surgical, or dental procedure (including a blood transfusion)
whether to be carried out on him or on any other person, shall if the child is or has
been married have the same effect as if he were of full age.
898 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) Where the consent of any other person to any medical, surgical, or dental procedure (including a blood transfusion) to be carried out on a child is necessary or sufficient, consent may be given –
(a) By a guardian of the child; or
(b) If there is no guardian in Niue or no such guardian can be found
with reasonable diligence or is capable of giving consent, by a person
in Niue who has been acting in the place of a parent; or
(c) If there is no person in Niue who has been so acting, or if no such
person can be found with reasonable diligence or is capable of giving
consent, by the Court.
(4) Where a child has been lawfully placed for the purpose of adoption in
the home of any person that person shall be deemed to be a guardian of the child
for the purposes of subsection (3).
(5) Nothing in this section shall limit or affect any enactment or rule of law
whereby in any circumstances –
(a) No consent or no express consent is necessary; or
(b) The consent of the child in addition to that of any other person is
necessary; or
(c) Subject to subsection (2), the consent of any other person instead of
the consent of the child is sufficient.

26 [Repealed by 2004/270]

27 Procedure and costs

(1) All proceedings under this Act shall, unless the Court otherwise directs,
be heard in private.
(2) In any proceedings under this Act the Court may make such order as
to costs as it thinks fit.

28 Evidence

In all proceedings under this Act (other than criminal proceedings), and
whether by way of hearing in the first instance or by way of appeal, or otherwise
howsoever, the Court may receive any evidence that it thinks fit, whether it is
otherwise admissible in a court of law or not.

29 [Repealed by 2004/270]

30 Solicitor or counsel may be appointed

The Court may appoint a solicitor or counsel to assist it or to represent any
child who is the subject of or who is otherwise a party to proceedings under this
Act, and where any solicitor or counsel is so appointed his fees and expenses shall
be paid by such other party or parties to those proceedings as the Court shall
order or, if the Court so decides, shall be paid out of money appropriated for the
purpose by Assembly.

31 Appeals

(1) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(2) An appeal shall lie to the Court of Appeal from any order or decision of
the High Court under this Act, other than an order or decision under section 13.
(3) Except on an appeal on a question of law, the Court of Appeal may
rehear the whole or any part of the evidence, or may receive further evidence, if it
thinks that the interests of justice so require.
(4) The decision of the Court of Appeal shall in every case be final.

Guardianship Act 1968

899

32 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations for the purposes of this Act and for providing
for the enforcement in Niue of orders with respect to the custody and upbringing
of and access to children made in other countries, and relating to the enforcement
in other countries of orders made in Niue with respect to the custody and
upbringing of and access to children.

33 Act to be code

(1) Except as otherwise expressly provided in this Act, this Act shall have
effect in place of the rules of the common law and of equity relating to the
guardianship and custody of children.
(2) (a) Subject to section 9, no person shall be appointed as or shall have
any powers as guardian of the property of any child.
(b) Nothing in this Act shall limit or affect any power of the Court in
relation to any property held on trust or to the administration
thereof.
(3) In matters not provided for by this Act, the Court shall have all the
powers in respect of the persons of children as does the High Court of New Zealand.

34 [Repealed by 2004/270]

35-38 [Spent]

–––––––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
[Not reproduced]

900 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

901

INCOME TAX ACT 1961

1961/9 – 16 March 1961

41A Low income rebate

42-44 [Repealed]

45 Rebate for support of dependant relatives

46 [Repealed]

47 Special exemption for life insurance

premium and superannuation fund

contributions

47A Special exemption for primary produce

income

47B Rebate for church donations

48 Apportionment of special exemptions

and rebates

General Exemptions

49 Incomes wholly exempt from taxation

902 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

77 Interest on debentures issued in substitution for shares

78 Payment of excessive remuneration or share of profits to relatives in certain cases

79 Excessive remuneration by company to shareholder or director

Country of Derivation of Income

80 Liability for assessment of income

derived from Niue and abroad

81 Place of residence, how determined

82 Classes of income deemed to be derived

from Niue

83 Apportionment where income derived

partly in Niue and partly elsewhere

84 Relief from double taxation

85 Arrangements for relief from double

taxation

Income derived by a Trustee

86 Special provisions with respect to trustees

87 Income received by trustee after death of

deceased person

88 Deduction from estate income of

irrecoverable book debts of deceased

taxpayer

Provisions relating to Companies and Associations

71 Profits of mutual associations in respect

of transactions with members

72 Overseas insurance companies other than

life insurance companies

73 Companies with substantially the same

shareholders or under the same control

74 Liability of new companies for tax

payable by former companies with

substantially the same share holders or

under the same control

75 Defining when a company is under the

control of any person

76 Floating rate of interest on debentures

PART 6

AGENTS AND NON-RESIDENTS

Interpretation

89 “Absentee” defined

90 Rate and amount of tax payable by agent

91 Liability of principal not affected

92 Agent may recover tax from principal

93 Agent may retain from moneys of

principal amount required for tax

94 Assessment deemed authority for

payment of tax by agent

95 Agents to be personally liable for

payment of tax

96 Agents to make returns and be assessed

as principal

97 Relation of principal and agent arising in

effect

Special Cases of Agency

98 Liability of mortgagee in possession

99 Guardian of person under disability to be

his agent

100 Local and public authorities and

companies deemed agent of debenture

holders

101 Modification in respect of income from

company debentures, or local or public

authority debentures

Income Tax Act 1961

903

102 Recovery of income tax payable in respect of alimony or maintenance

Agents of absentees and non-residents

103 Liability of agent of absentee principal for

returns and tax

104 Partner of absentee deemed agent

105 Master of ship or caption of aircraft

deemed agent of absentee owner

106 Tenant, mortgagor or other debtor, to be

agent of absentee landlord, mortgagee or

other creditor

107 Person having disposal of income

deemed agent

108 Company to be agent of absentee

shareholders

109 Banking company to be agent of absentee

depositors

110 Premiums on insurance effected with

persons not carrying on business in Niue

111 Liability as agent of employer of non­

resident taxpayer and employer ’s agent

112 Non-resident trader to be agent of

employees in Niue

113 Agents in Niue of principals resident or

carrying on business abroad

PART 6A

TAX DEDUCTIONS BY EMPLOYERS

113A Application of this Part

113B Tax deductions to be made by employers

113C Amount of tax deductions

113D Tax codes

113E Dependants

113F Tax code declaration

113G Tax deduction to be credited to individual

113H Contribution to superannuation funds

113I Tax deduction from amounts credited to

or applied for employees

113J Employee to pay deductions to Treasurer

113K Records to be kept by employer

113L Payment of tax deductions to Treasurer

113M Tax deductions protected from creditors

113N Employers who fail to make tax

deductions

113O Additional tax for default in making tax

113P Offences

113Q Application of other provisions to this

Part

113R Witholding payments

PART 7

PAYMENT AND RECOVERY OF TAX

114 Due date for payment of tax

115 Payment of tax

115A Payments of tax

116 If default, additional tax to be charged

117 Mode of recovery of unpaid tax

118 Deduction of income tax from payment

due to defaulters

119 Procedure where defendant absent from

Niue

120 Particulars of claim or demand

121 Collector may appear in legal

proceedings by officer of the public

service

122 Costs against Treasurer

123 Proceedings not affected by vacancy or

change in office of Treasurer

124 Crown Proceedings Act not affected

125 Recovery of tax paid by one person on

behalf of another

126 Payment of income tax by persons

leaving Niue

PART 8

PENALTIES

127 Penalty for failure to furnish returns

128 Fines recoverable

129 Information may be laid within ten years

130 Penal tax in case of evasion

131 Nature of penal tax

132 Assessment of penal tax

133 Objections to penal tax

134 Recovery of penal tax

135 Recovery of penal tax from executors or

administrators

136 Amendment of assessment of penal tax

137 Limitation of time for assessment of penal

tax

138 Recovery of penal tax not affected by

conviction of taxpayer

PART 9

GENERAL

139 Treasure to have power to inspect books

and documents

140 Information to be furnished on request

of Treasurer

141 Inquiry before a Judge or Commissioner

of the High Court

142 Inquiry by Treasurer

143 Offences

144 Keeping of business records

145 Employers to make returns as to

employees

146 Returns of interest paid on deposits

147 Returns as to debentures and interest

thereon

148 Excess tax may be repaid within four

years

904 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

149

In cases of serious hardship Treasurer

151

Debentures issued free of income tax

may grant relief to taxpayer

152

Extension of time

150

Agreements purporting to alter incidence

153

Airlines liable for taxation

of taxation to be void

1 Short title

This is the Income Tax Act 1961.

SCHEDULES

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
PART 1
INTERPRETATION
“agent” means any person declared by this Act to be an agent for the purposes of income tax:
“assessable income” means income of any kind which is not exempted from income tax otherwise than by way of a “special exemption” expressly authorised as such by this Act:
“book and document” and “book or document” include all books, accounts, rolls, records, registers, papers and other documents:
“business” includes any profession, trade, manufacture, or undertaking carried on for pecuniary profit:
“charitable purpose” includes every charitable purpose, whether it relates
to the relief of poverty, the advancement of education or religion, or
any other matter beneficial to the community;
“Collector” means the Collector of Inland Revenue and includes any person
for the time being authorised to exercise or perform any of the powers
or functions of the Collector;
“company” means a Niuean company or any body corporate whether
incorporated in Niue or elsewhere, but does not include a local or public
authority;
“debentures” includes debenture stock, and “debenture-holder” includes
the owner of debenture stock;
“dependant” in relation to an employee means a person in terms of section
113E;
“dividends” in relation to any company shall be deemed to include –
(a) All sums distributed in any manner and under any name among
all or any of the shareholders of the company;
(b) Any credit given by the company without fully adequate
consideration in money or money’s worth to any of its shareholders
in respect of the amount unpaid on any shares that are not fully
paid up;
(c) The paid up value of any share allotted by the company to any of
its shareholders as such to the extent to which that value exceeds
the value of the consideration in money or money’s worth (if any)
paid or given by the shareholders to the company in respect of the
shares allotted;
(d) The value of any other property of any kind whatsoever distributed
by the company to any of its shareholders as such;
(e) All amounts received by any shareholder in respect of his shares
(whether in money or money’s worth) upon the winding up of the
company in excess of the amount paid up on his shares;

Income Tax Act 1961

905
(f) Where any property of the company is sold or otherwise disposed of to a shareholder without consideration or for a consideration which in the opinion of the Treasurer is less than its market price or its true value, the excess of the market price or its true value, the excess of the market price of that property on the day it was sold or disposed of over the price (if any) realised on the sale or disposition or, if there is no market price, the excess of the price deemed to have been realised pursuant to a determination of the Treasurer under section 53(2)(b) over the price (if any) realised on the sale or disposition, and it shall be ground for an objection to an assessment of income tax under Part 3 that any determination of the Collector made for the purposes of this paragraph is erroneous in fact, and subject to the taxpayer ’s right of objection to the Treasurer ’s assessment under Part 3 shall also include any moneys advanced by the company to or for the benefit of any of its shareholders irrespective of the year in which the moneys were advanced if, in the opinion of the Treasurer, the making of the advance was not a bona fide investment by the company, but was virtually a distribution of profits, but shall not in any case include any payment or other transaction which, in the opinion of the Treasurer, is or is equivalent to a return of share capital:
Provided that where any moneys advanced by a company to or for the benefit of any shareholders and deemed by virtue of this section to constitute a dividend are subsequently repaid to the company, the Treasurer may amend in such manner as may be thereby rendered necessary the assessment made in respect of income derived by that shareholder, during the income year in which the advance was made, and may at any time refund any tax found to have been paid in excess of the amount properly payable, notwithstanding anything to the contrary in section
147:
Provided also that if in any case the Treasurer sees fit, the expression “dividends”
shall be deemed not to include any payment or other transaction to the extent to
which, in the opinion of the Treasurer, that payment or transaction constitutes a
return to shareholders of premiums paid to the company in respect of the issue of
share capital by the company:
Provided also that where any company that has reduced the amount of the paid
up capital of any shareholder by writing off losses incurred by the company –
(i) Subsequently gives credit without fully adequate consideration
in money or money’s worth to that shareholder in respect of
the amount unpaid on any shares in the company, or
(ii) Subsequently allots shares to that shareholder the paid up value
of which shares exceeds the value of the consideration in money
or money’s worth (if any) paid or given by the shareholder to
the company for the shares – the expression “dividends” shall
for the purposes of this Act be deemed not to include the credit
so given or the paid up value of the shares so allotted, as the
case may be, to the extent that the Treasurer thinks just and
reasonable, having regard to the amount of the paid up capital
lost by the shareholder and any other relevant considerations;
“employee” means a person who receives or is entitled to receive a source
deduction payment;
“employer” means a person who pays or is liable to pay a source deduction
payment and includes ­
906 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(a) The manager or other principal officer in the case of an unincorporated body of persons;
(b) Each partner in the case of a partnership;
(c) Each person in whom the property has become vested or to whom
the control of the property has passed in the case of the estate of a
deceased person, a trust, a company in liquidation, or an assigned
estate, or in any other case where property is vested or controlled
in a fiduciary capacity;
“income year” means in respect of the income of any person, the year in
which that income has been derived by him;
“lease” means any disposition whatever by which a leasehold estate is
created;
“leasehold estate” includes any estate howsoever created, other than a
freehold estate;
“local authority” means a Village Council and includes any incorporated
instrument of local government in Niue whether possessing rating
powers or not;
“minerals” includes all minerals, metals, coal, oil, clay, stone, gravel, sand,
and precious stones;
“non-assessable income” shall have the meaning assigned to it in section
forty hereof;
“non-resident agent” means an agent within the meaning of this Act who,
being in Niue, has no fixed and permanent place of business or abode
there;
“notice” means a notice in writing given by causing the same to be delivered
to any person, or to be let at his usual or last know place of abode or
business in Niue or elsewhere, to be sent by post addressed to such
usual or last known place of abode or business, or if there are several
such places o business, then to any of them;
“officer” includes any person employed by the Niue Public Service
Commission acting under the authority of the Treasurer;
“overseas company” means any company other that a native company or
one incorporated in Niue;
“person” includes a local or public authority;
“prescribed” means prescribed by the Treasurer;
“public authority” means the Departments or other instruments of the
Government;
“salary or wages” in relation to any person means salary, wages, or
allowances (whether in cash or otherwise), including all sums received
or receivable by way of overtime pay, bonus, gratuity, extra salary,
commission, or remuneration of any kind in respect of and in relation
to the employment of that person;
“shareholder” includes any member of a company, whether the capital of
that company is divided into shares or not; and “share” includes any
interest in the capital of a company;
“source deduction payment” means a payment by way of salary or wages,
an extra emolument of a withholding payment;
“superannuation fund” means the Niue Government Superannuation Fund
and any superannuation fund established for the benefit of the
employees of any employer and approved for the time being by the
Treasurer for the purposes of this Act;
“tax” means income tax;

Income Tax Act 1961

907
“taxable income” means the residue of assessable income after deducting the amount of all special exemptions to which the taxpayer is entitled; “taxpayer” means a person chargeable with income tax, whether on his own account or as the agent or trustee of any other person, and includes
the executor or administrator of a deceased taxpayer; “trustee” includes an executor and administrator;
“year” means a year commencing on 1 April and ending on 31 March, both of these days being included;
“year of assessment” means the year for which income tax is payable.
PART 2
ADMINISTRATION

3 Treasurer to administer Act

(1) The Treasurer, subject to the control of Cabinet shall be charged with
the administration of the Act.
(2) Any certificate, notice, or other document bearing the written, stamped,
or printed signature of the Treasurer relating to any matter provided for in this
Act shall, until the contrary is proved, be deemed to have been duly signed by the
person by whom it purports to have been signed.
(3) Judicial notice shall be taken of every such signature and of the fact
that the person whose signature it purports to be holds or has held the office of
Treasurer.

4 Officers to maintain secrecy

(1) The Treasurer and every other officer of the Government –
(a) Shall maintain and aid in maintaining the secrecy of all matters
relating to this Act which come to his knowledge and shall not
communicate any such matters to any person except for the purpose
of carrying into effect this Act or any other enactment imposing
taxes or duties payable to the Government; and also
(b) Shall before he begins to perform any official duty under this Act,
take and subscribe an oath of fidelity and secrecy to maintain secrecy
in conformity with this section.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1)(a), it is hereby declared
that no officer of the Government shall be required to produce in any court any
book or document or to divulge or communicate to any court any matter or thing
coming under his notice in the performance of his duties as an officer of the
Government, except when it is necessary to do so for the purpose of carrying into
effect the Act or any other enactment imposing taxes or duties payable to the
Government.
(3) Every person who wilfully acts in contravention of this section or in
contravention of the true intent of any such oath shall be liable on conviction to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or to a fine not exceeding 2
penalty units.
PART 3
RETURNS AND ASSESSMENTS

5 Annual returns by taxpayers for purposes of income tax

(1) For the purpose of the assessment and levy of income tax every taxpayer
shall in each year furnish to the Treasurer a return setting forth a complete statement
of all the assessable income derived by him during the preceding year together
with such other particulars as may be prescribed.
908 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
shall –
(2) Except as otherwise provided, every return of income under the Act
(a) Be made and furnished in such of the forms prescribed by the
Treasurer for the purpose as is applicable;
(b) Contain the information and particulars mentioned or referred to
in that form;
(c) Be verified by declaration as therein set forth;
(d) Be accompanied by all such balance sheets, profit and loss accounts,
statements, and other documents as are mentioned in the form or
are otherwise required by the Treasurer.
(3) Any further or other return which a person is required to make or
furnish to the Treasurer under section 11 or 13 or in pursuance of any other statutory provision shall, unless the form is prescribed by the statutory provision, be made and furnished in the form prescribed by the Treasurer.
(4) Annual returns of income shall be made –
(a) By all companies and all persons in business whether for the whole
or part of the income year irrespective of whether a profit has been
made or a loss incurred provided that this requirement shall not
apply to any planter whose total income from all sources during
the year does not exceed $600;
(b) By all other persons, whether taxpayers or not, who derive income
from salary, wages, interest, rent, annuity, dividend or other sources
where the total income so derived exceeds three hundred pounds
per annum.
(5) (a) All returns of income and any other returns required the Act to be
furnished to the Treasurer shall be furnished by posting or delivering
the same to the Treasurer or other authorised officer at the office of
the Treasurer or at such other place as the Treasurer may direct.
(b) Such direction may be given by the insertion of a general direction
in any return form prescribed for use in any year of assessment or
in such other manner as the Treasurer thinks fit.
(6) Wherever a person is required by this Act or the Treasurer to furnish a
return to the Treasurer, it shall be the duty of that person to procure and make the
required return and to take all steps necessary to ensure that the return is received
at the place where or the person to whom under this Act the return is required to
be furnished.
(7) (a) Every person who furnishes a return shall, in the return, state his
postal address, and shall, within one month of any change in his
postal address, give to the Treasurer at the place where he furnished
his return notice in writing of the change, and of his new postal
address.
(b) The posting of any notice addressed to a person at the last address
given by him under this Act shall be sufficient service of notice on
him for the purposes of the Act.

6 Returns to annual balance date

(1) In lieu of furnishing a return under section 5 for any year ending on 31
March of that year, any taxpayer may with the consent of the Treasurer elect to furnish a return for the year ending on the date of the annual balance of his accounts, and in any such case the income derived during any year ending on a date between 1 October and the next succeeding 30 September inclusive, shall for the purposes of this Act be deemed to have been derived during the year ending on 31 March falling between the same two dates.

Income Tax Act 1961

909
(2) Any election made by a taxpayer for the purposes of this section shall continue in force unless and until it is altered by the taxpayer with the prior approval in writing of the Treasurer.

7 Consequential adjustments on change in return date

(1) In this section –
“new return date” means in the case of a taxpayer who has changed his
return date, the date to which the change was made or, if he has made
more than one change, means the date to which the last change was
made;
“original return date” means in the case of a taxpayer who has changed his
return date, the return date immediately prior to the new return date;
“return date” means the last day of the period for which a return of income
is required to be made;
(2) Where, in any case a new return date has been approved by the
Treasurer, the taxpayer shall furnish a return to the original return date and another
return for the period between the original return date and the new return date.
(3) All returns of income made under subsection (2) to a date falling
between 1 October and the next succeeding 30 September inclusive shall be deemed
to be returns of income derived during the year ending on 31 March falling between
those same two dates, and the income derived by a taxpayer during that period
shall for the purposes of assessment, be added to any other income derived for
the same year, and he shall be assessed and liable for income tax accordingly.
(4) Where, for the purposes of this section, a taxpayer is assessed for income
tax on a return made for a period of less than a year, he shall be entitled, by way of
special exemptions, only to an amount bearing to the total exemptions to which
he would be entitled for a full year the same proportion as the number of days in
that period bears to the number of days in a year; and where a taxpayer is assessed
on a return or returns for a period of more than a year, the deduction to which he
shall be entitled by way of special exemptions shall be proportionately increased.
(5) Where, for the purposes of this section, a taxpayer is assessed for income
tax on returns made for a period that is less or greater than a year, the rate of tax
shall be determined as for a year, and for the purposes of this subsection the taxable
and non-assessable income of a taxpayer shall be deemed to have been derived at
a uniform daily rate throughout the period for which the returns have been made
and where that period is less than a year that daily rate shall be deemed to have
continued for a year.
(6) Where a taxpayer has been assessed for income tax on a return made to
any date other than 31 March in any year, the income derived by that taxpayer
shall be deemed to have been assessed for tax to that other date, and not to 31
March.
(7) For the purposes of giving effect to this section and section 6, the
Treasurer may, for any year or years of assessment, make all such assessments or
additional assessments as he may deem necessary, notwithstanding anything to
the contrary in this Act.

8 Returns by partners, co-trustees and joint adventurers

(1) When income is derived by two or more persons jointly as partners,
co-trustees or otherwise, the following provision shall apply –
(a) In the case of trustees, they shall make a return of that income, and
shall be jointly assessable thereon and jointly and severally liable
for the tax so assessed.
910 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) In the case of partners –
(i) they shall make a joint return of the income of the partnership,
setting forth the amount of that income and the shares of the
several partners therein and every such return shall be signed
by all the partners;
(ii) each partner shall make a separate return of all income derived
by him and not included in any such joint return;
(iii) there shall be no joint assessment but each partner shall be
separately assessed and liable for the tax payable on his total
income, including his share of the income of any partnership
in which he is a partner.
(c) In any case other than that of co-trustees or partners, each person
by whom income is so derived shall include in his return the amount
of his share in the joint income and shall be assessed and liable
accordingly.
(2) Where a husband and wife are carrying on business together or deriving
income jointly without any formal partnership agreement, the whole of the income
derived from the business or jointly shall, for the purposes of assessment, be
deemed to have been equally split between the husband and wife and subsection
(1)(b) shall in all respects apply as if there is a bona fide partnership agreement.

9 Returns by executors or administrators

(1) The executor or administrator of a deceased taxpayer shall, in respect
of all income derived by that taxpayer in his life-time, make the same returns as
the taxpayer ought to have made or would have been bound to make if he had
remained alive, and the Treasurer may require the executor or administrator to
make such further returns relative to that income as the Treasurer thinks necessary
and may assess the executor or administrator for income tax on that income in the
same manner in which the taxpayer might have been assessed had he remained
alive.
(2) The tax so assessed shall be deemed to be a liability incurred by the deceased taxpayer in his lifetime, and the executor or administrator of the taxpayer shall be liable for the same accordingly.

10 Special returns and special assessments

(1) This section applies to the following persons –
(a) An agent;
(b) A non-resident trader;
(c) A person who is believed by the Treasurer to be about to leave Niue
or to be about to discontinue the carrying on of business in Niue;
(d) A person who has ceased to carry on business in Niue or to derive
assessable income;
(e) The executors or administrators of a deceased taxpayer in respect
of income derived by him in his lifetime;
(f) A person who has become bankrupt, or a company which is in
course of being wound up.
(2) The Treasurer may at any time during the income year or in any
subsequent year, require any person to whom this section applies to make a return
of income derived from any specified transaction or transactions or during any
specific period, and may assess him for income tax on the income so returned, or
when default is made in making such a return, or the Treasurer is dissatisfied
therewith, then on such sum as the Treasurer thinks reasonable, and shall give
notice of the assessment to the person so assessed.

Income Tax Act 1961

911
(3) Any person so assessed shall have the same right of objection as if he had been assessed in the ordinary course.
(4) Tax so assessed shall be payable on demand, which may be made in and by the notice of assessment, or at any later date, and the tax shall be recoverable in the same manner as income tax assessed in the ordinary course.
(5) No assessment made under this section shall in any manner preclude a
subsequent assessment of the same person in the ordinary course in respect of the
whole of the income derived by him during the income year with respect to which
the assessment under this section was made, but in such case the tax paid under
the earlier assessment shall be credited in the subsequent assessment.

11 Other annual returns

In addition to the foregoing returns every person, whether a taxpayer or
not, shall make to the Treasurer such annual returns as may be prescribed for the
purposes of this Act.

12 Dates by which returns to be furnished

(1) The above-mentioned returns shall be made in each year on or before a
date or dates of which the Treasurer gives public notice.
(2) Such notice shall be given by publishing the same in the Gazette or any
newspaper published in Niue or in such other manner as the Treasurer may think
necessary and sufficient.

13 Treasurer may require other returns to be made

In addition to the returns above-mentioned, every person, whether a
taxpayer or not, shall as and when required by the Treasurer make such further or
other returns as the Treasurer requires for the purposes of this Act.

14 Presumption as to authority

A return purporting to be made by or on behalf of any person shall for all
purposes be deemed to have been made by that person or by his authority, as the
case may be, unless the contrary is proved.

15 Treasurer to make assessments

(1) From the returns made as aforesaid and from any other information in
his possession the Treasurer shall in and for every year and from time to time and
at any time as may be necessary, make assessments in respect of every taxpayer,
setting forth the amount upon which tax is payable and the amount of the tax.
(2) Every such assessment shall be made in such form and manner as the
Treasurer thinks fit, and shall be signed by him.

16 Rates of income tax

(1) The Treasurer shall in any year of assessment assess the income tax of
any taxpayer at the rates as set out in Schedule 1.
(2) If in any year of assessment the rates of tax as set out in Schedule 1 are
varied by the passing of an amending Act, every assessment of income tax made
in respect of that year before the passing of any such amending Act may be
amended and reassessed on the basis of the new rates.
912 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

17 Arbitrary assessment

(1) Where any business carried on in Niue –
(a) Is controlled exclusively or principally by persons not resident in
Niue, or
(b) Is carried on by a company not resident in Niue, or by a company
in which more than one half of the shares are held by persons not
resident in Niue, or
(c) Is carried on by a company which holds, or on behalf of which
other persons hold, more than one half of the shares in a company
not resident in Niue –
and it appears from the returns made to the Treasurer that the business produces
no taxable income or less than the amount of taxable income which in the opinion
of the Treasurer might be expected to arise from the business, the person carrying
on the business in Niue shall, notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this
Act, be assessable for and liable to pay income tax on a taxable income of such
amount as the Treasurer determines, being at the option of the Treasurer either
such proportion as he determines of the total receipts (whether cash or credit) of
the business or such proportion as he determines of the total purchase moneys
paid or payable (whether in cash or by the granting of credit) in the conduct of the
business.
(2) For the purposes of this section the place of residence of any person
other than a company and the place of residence of any company shall be
determined under section 80.

18 Assessment where default in furnishing returns

If any person makes default in furnishing any return, or if the Treasurer is
not satisfied with the return made by any person, or if the Treasurer has reason to
suppose that any person although he has not made a return is a taxpayer, he may
make an assessment of the amount on which in his judgment tax ought to be
liable to pay the tax so assessed, save in so far as he establishes on objection that
the assessment is excessive or that he is not chargeable with tax.

19 Amendment of assessments

(1) The Treasurer may make all such alterations in or additions to an
assessment as he thinks necessary in order to ensure the correctness of it,
notwithstanding that tax already assessed may have been paid.
(2) If any such alteration or addition has the effect of imposing any fresh
liability or increasing any existing liability, notice of it shall be given by the Treasurer
to the taxpayer affected, who shall, unless the alteration or addition was made
with his consent, be entitled to object to it under the provisions as to objections
hereinafter contained.

20 Limitation of time for amendment of assessment

When any person has made returns and has been assessed for income tax
for any year, it shall not be lawful for the Treasurer to alter the assessment so as to
increase the amount of it after the expiration of 4 years from the end of the year in
which the assessment was made or (in any case where in the opinion of the
Treasurer the returns so made are fraudulent or wilfully misleading or omit all
mention of income which is of a particular nature or was derived from a particular
source, and in respect of which a return is required to be made) after the expiration
of 10 years from the end of the year in which the assessment was made.

Income Tax Act 1961

913

21 Validity of assessment not affected by failure to comply with Act

The validity of an assessment shall not be affected by reason that any of the
provisions of this Act have not been complied with.

22 Except in proceedings on objection assessments deemed correct

Except in proceedings on objection to an assessment under the provisions
hereinafter contained, no assessment made by the Treasurer shall be disputed in
any Court or in any proceedings either on the ground that the person so assessed
is not a taxpayer or on any other ground, and except as aforesaid, every such
assessment and all the particulars thereof shall be conclusively deemed and taken
to be correct, and the liability of the person so assessed shall be determined
accordingly.

23 Evidence of returns and assessments

The production of any documents under the hand of the Treasurer
purporting to be a copy of extract from any return or assessment shall in all Courts
and in all proceedings be sufficient evidence of the original, and the production of
the original shall not be necessary, and all Courts shall in all proceedings take
judicial notice of the signature of the Treasurer either to the original or to any such
copy or extract.

24 Notice of assessment to taxpayer

(1) As soon as conveniently may be after an assessment is made the
Treasurer shall cause notice of the assessment to be given to the taxpayer.
(2) The omission to give any such notice shall not invalidate the assessment
or in any manner affect its operation.

25 [Repealed 3/83/1984]

PART 4
OBJECTIONS AND ASSESSMENTS
=26 How objections originated
(1) Any person who has been assessed for income tax may object to that
assessment by delivering or posting to the Treasurer a written notice of objection
stating shortly the grounds of his objection so that it reaches the Treasurer within
the time specified in that behalf in the notice of assessment, not being less than 6
weeks after the date on which that notice of assessment is given.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) No notice of objection given after the time so specified shall be of any
force or effect unless the Treasurer in his discretion accepts the same and gives
notice to the objector accordingly.

27 Treasurer may amend assessment

The Treasurer shall consider all such objections and may alter the assessment
pursuant to it; but if an objection is not allowed by the Treasurer, the objector may,
within 6 months after the date on which notice of the disallowance is given to him
by or on behalf of the Treasurer, by notice in writing to the Treasurer require that
the objection be heard and determined by the Court before a Judge, and in that
event the objection shall be heard and determined in the Court; and the Court
shall for the purpose of hearing and determining the objection, whatever the
amount involved, have all the powers vested in it in its ordinary civil jurisdiction
as if in an action between the objecting taxpayer and the Treasurer.
914 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

28 Hearing of objections by High Court

The procedure for the institution, hearing and determination of such
proceedings in the High Court shall be in accordance with the ordinary practice
of that Court.

29 Burden of proof on objector

On the hearing and determination of all objections to assessments of income
tax the burden of proof shall be on the objector, and the Court may receive such
evidence as it thinks fit, whether receivable in accordance with law in other
proceedings or not.

30 Costs

On the determination of any objection the Court may award such costs as
it deems just either against the Treasurer or against the objector.

31 Court may confirm, cancel or alter the assessment

On the determination of any such objection the Court may either confirm
or cancel the assessment, or increase or reduce the amount, and the assessment
shall be altered by the Treasurer, if necessary, so as to conform to that determination.

32 Appeals to Court of Appeal

The determination of the High Court on any such objection shall be subject
to appeal to the Court of Appeal on any question of law but shall be final and
conclusive on any question of fact unless the High Court is satisfied that the amount
of tax bona fide in dispute between the objector and the Treasurer exceeds $1000
in which case the Treasurer or the objector may appeal to the Court of Appeal on
any question of fact.

33 Appeals from assessments

(1) In this Act “appeal” means a proceeding in the High Court, or an appeal
to the Collector under this Act, for the determination of an objection made under
the Act to an assessment of income tax, and the term “appellant” means the person
by whom any such objection has been made.
(2) The parties to the appeal shall be the appellant and the Treasurer as
respondent.
(3) (a) For the purpose of every appeal the Treasurer shall state and sign a
case setting forth the facts as alleged by him, the nature of the
assessment made by him, the ground of objection thereto, and the
question for the determination of the Court or Collector as the case
may be.
(b) The case, so stated and signed, shall be filed by the Treasurer in the
High Court or with the Collector, as the case may be, and the filing
of the case shall be deemed to be the institution of the appeal.
(c) A copy of the case so filed shall be sent by the Treasurer to the
appellant, either through the post office or otherwise.
(4) Within fourteen days after the filing of the case by the Treasurer or
within such further time as the Treasurer may allow the appellant may, if he thinks
fit file an answer to the case. The answer shall set forth the facts as alleged by the
appellant and the grounds of his appeal.
(5) The case as stated and filed by the Treasurer shall not be conclusive as
to the matters set forth in it, either against the appellant or the Treasurer, except so
far as agreed to in writing by or on behalf of the Treasurer and the appellant.

Income Tax Act 1961

915
(6) After the filing of the case by the Treasurer the Registrar of the Court, or the Collector as the case may be, shall on the application of the Treasurer or of the appellant, appoint a time and place for the hearing of the appeal, that time not being earlier (except with the consent of the Treasurer and the appellant) than 21 days after the date of the filing of the case.
(7) Reasonable notice by post or otherwise of the time and place so
appointed shall be given by the person on whose application the appointment
has been made to the other party to the appeal.
(8) At the time and place so appointed, a Judge of the High Court or in the
absence of a Judge the Registrar of the Court or the Collector, as the case may be,
may adjourn the hearing to any other time or place, and so on from time to time.
(9) If either party fails to appear at the hearing, the Court or the Collector,
as the case may be, shall in its or his discretion either adjourn the hearing or
determine the appeal in the same manner as if both parties were present.
(10) The procedure at the hearing of the appeal shall be the same, with
all necessary modifications, as if the appeal were an action which the appellant is
he plaintiff and the Treasurer is the defendant.

34 Obligation to pay tax not suspended by objection or appeal

The obligation to pay and the right to receive and recover any tax shall not
be suspended by any objection, or appeal, but if the objector succeeds the amount
(if any) of the tax received by the Treasurer in excess of the amount which, according
to the decision on the hearing of the objection, or appeal, was properly payable
shall forthwith be repaid to him by the Treasurer.

35 Determination of objection not to affect other income

The determination of an objection under any of the foregoing provisions
shall relate solely to the income which is the subject of the assessment objected to
and shall not affect the right of the Treasurer to assess any other income of the
objector, or to amend the assessment objected to in any manner rendered necessary
by the assessment of such other income.
(1) “Absentee” in this part means a person whose home has not been in
Niue during any part of the income year.
(2) A taxpayer shall not be deemed to be an absentee within the meaning
of this Part if the Treasurer is satisfied that the absence of the taxpayer from Niue
during the income year has been for the sake of his or her health, or of the health
of the husband or wife, as the case may be, or of any child of the taxpayer
(3) No person who is absent from Niue in the service in any capacity of the
Government nor the wife of any such person if she is absent from Niue with him,
shall by reason of such absence be deemed to be an absentee within the meaning
of this Part.

38 Income tax imposed

(1) Subject to this Act, there shall be levied and paid for the use of the
Crown for the year commencing on 1 April in each year, a tax herein referred to as income tax.
916 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) Subject to this Act income tax shall be payable by every person on all income derived by him during the year for which the tax is payable.
(3) The year in which income is so derived is in this Act referred to as the income year, and the year for which income tax is payable is in this Act referred to as the year of assessment.

39 Rates fixed

Income tax shall be assessed and levied on the taxable income of every
taxpayer at such rate or rates as are set out in Schedule 1.

40 Where non-assessable income to be taken into account

(1) Where in any income year any taxpayer has derived assessable income
and has also derived any non-assessable income from a source referred to in
subsection (2), then, notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Act, the rate
of tax payable on this taxable income shall be computed as if the non-assessable
income derived by him as aforesaid were assessable income.
(2) The non-assessable income referred to in subsection (1) includes –
(a) (i) Income derived from securities issued by the Government
subject to the condition that the income derived therefrom shall
be exempt from income tax;
(ii) Such income when payable out of Niue to an absentee shall
not be so included;
(b) Income derived from debentures issued by companies on terms
providing for the payment of income tax by such companies as
proved by section 150, and income derived from debentures to
which sections 75 and 76 apply;
(c) Dividends or other profits derived from shares or other rights of
membership in companies save that such dividends or other profits
when derived by an absentee from sources out of Niue shall not be
so included.

41 Personal rebate

In the assessment of every taxpayer, other than an absentee, company, public
authority, or unincorporated body, there shall be allowed as a rebate of income
tax for that income year the sum of $156.

41A Low income rebate

Special Exemptions

(1) A person, other than – (a) An absentee; or
(b) A company,
with an assessable income of less than $20,000 is entitled to a rebate on the income
tax that is payable or would otherwise be payable on that income.
(2) The rebate referred to in subsection (1) shall be at the rate set out in
Schedule 3.

42 – 44 [Repealed 2/118/1987]

45 Rebate for support of dependent relatives

(1) In the assessment of every taxpayer, (other than an absentee) who
contributes towards the support of any relative during any income year there
shall, subject to this section, be allowed as a rebate of income tax for that income
year in respect of each such dependant relative, the sum of $26.

Income Tax Act 1961

917
(2) (a) Where a person is a dependant relative for the purposes of this section only one rebate shall be allowed in respect of that person notwithstanding that more than one taxpayer may have contributed towards the support of that relative.
(b) In the case of 2 or more taxpayers claiming a rebate in respect of the same dependant relative the Treasurer shall allow the rebate for the taxpayer who in his opinion has made the greatest financial contribution to the support of that dependant relative.
(3) No rebate shall be allowed under this section in respect of any relative
if the Treasurer is satisfied that the relative has sufficient income or capital for his
own support and that the contributions towards his support were not necessary.
(4) For the purpose of this section “relative” means –
(a) A child, step-child, or adopted child who at any time during the
income year is under the age of eighteen years, or who, being over
the age of eighteen years, is suffering from any permanent mental
or physical infirmity and is thereby permanently incapacitated from
earning his or her own living or is attending full-time a university
or educational institution recognized by the Treasurer; and
(b) Any other person proved to the satisfaction of the Treasurer to be a
relation of the taxpayer by blood, marriage, or adoption (not being
the wife or husband of the taxpayer); including a former wife of a
taxpayer; and including also any child, not being a child, step-child
or adopted child of the taxpayer who is supported by the taxpayer
as a foster child and who otherwise satisfies the requirements of
paragraph (a): Provided that:
(i) where the wife of a taxpayer is not living with him she shall be
deemed to be a relative of the taxpayer for the purposes of this
section;
(ii) a rebate under this section in respect of the wife of a taxpayer
shall be allowable only where the amount of it exceeds the
amount of the rebate to which the taxpayer is entitled in respect
of his wife under section 42 and shall be allowable in
substitution for the last-mentioned rebate;
(iii) for the purpose of this section the wife of a taxpayer shall be
deemed to be living with him unless the Treasurer is satisfied
that she is in fact separated and living separate and apart from
him, whether pursuant to a decree, order, or judgment of any
Court, or pursuant to an agreement for separation, or by reason
of the desertion of one of the parties by the other of them, or
otherwise.

46 [Repealed by 2/118/1987]

47 Special exemption for life insurance premiums and superannuation fund contributions

(1) Every taxpayer, (other than an absentee,) who has effected an insurance on his own life for his own benefit or for the benefit of his wife or his children shall be entitled to a deduction by way of special exemption from his assessable income of the amount of premium paid in the income year in respect of that insurance.
(2) [Repealed by 1999/241]
(3) The deductions by way of special exemption provided for in this section
shall not in any case exceed in the aggregate the sum of $800.
918 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(4) Notwithstanding subsection (1) a special exemption shall not be allowed under that subsection in respect of the premiums paid on any pure endowment policy, that is to say, a policy of life insurance which does not provide for the payment of a specified capital sum on the death of the assured.

47A Special exemption for primary produce income

(1) Subject to subsection (2), the first $5,000 income earned by a taxpayer
during the income year that derives from the production of primary produce, or
from the making of plaited baskets, trays, table-mats, grass skirts or any other
plaited ware or handwork shall be exempt from taxation.
(2) Cabinet may issue instructions as to the nature of receipts that shall be
required to be produced in order to qualify for the exemption give under subsection
(1).

47B Rebate for church donations

(1) In the assessment of every taxpayer (other than an absentee) who
during the income year makes cash donations to any Church situated in Niue and
which in the opinion of the Treasurer is a recognized religious organization there
shall be allowed as a rebate of income tax for that income year an amount equal to
20 cents for every complete dollar up to a maximum of $100 donated to any such
church or religious organization.
(2) For the purpose of this section all donations must be in cash and
evidenced by a receipt.

48 Apportionment of special exemptions and rebates

(1) Every person arriving in or departing from Niue during any income
year, shall be entitled to a deduction by way of special exemption from his
assessable income, or to a rebate of income tax in his assessment for that income
year, of –
(a) An amount equal to the same proportion of every deduction by way of special exemption or rebate to which he would have been entitled under sections 45, 47A and 47B, as the proportion that the number of days during which the income is deemed to have been earned bears to the numbers of days in the income year; and
(b) Such allowance under sections 46 and 47 as the Treasurer may
consider appropriate.
(2) (a) For the purposes of this section an “absentee” shall be considered
to be entitled to the same special exemptions under sections 45, 47,
47A and 47B as if he were a taxpayer other than an absentee.
(b) Nothing in this subsection shall entitle an “absentee” to the special
exemptions or rebates provided under sections 45, 47, 47A and 47B
in circumstances other than as provided in this section.

General Exemptions

49 Incomes wholly exempt from taxation

(1) The following incomes shall be exempt from taxation –
(a) The income, other than income received in trust, of a local authority,
or of any public authority;
(b) Income derived from sinking funds in respect of any public debt or
of the debt of any local authority;

Income Tax Act 1961

919
(c) Income derived by any person from any pension or allowance granted by any Government in respect of any war or in respect of any disability or disablement attributable to or aggravated by service in any naval, military, air, or police force;
(d) Dividends and other profits derived from shares or other rights of membership in companies other than companies which are exempt from income tax;
(e) Income derived by women in the form of payments in the nature of alimony or maintenance made to her by her husband or former husband out of income belonging to him;
(f) Income derived by the trustees of a superannuation fund;
(g) Income (not being income of the kind referred to in paragraph (h)
derived by trustees in trust for charitable purposes, or derived by
any society or institution established exclusively for such purposes
and not carried on for private pecuniary profit;
(h) Income derived directly or indirectly from any business carried on
by or on behalf of or for the benefit of trustees in trust for charitable
purposes within Niue, or derived directly or indirectly from any
business carried on by or on behalf of or for the benefit of any society
or institution established exclusively for such purposes and not
carried on for private pecuniary profits:
Provided that if the aforesaid purposes are not limited to Niue the
Treasurer may apportion the income in such manner as he deems
just and reasonable between such purposes within Niue and the
like purposes out of Niue, and may allow to the trustees, society or
institution a partial exemption accordingly;
(i) Income derived by any society or association, whether incorporated
or not, which is, in the opinion of the Treasurer, established
substantially or primarily for the purpose of promoting any amateur
game or sport if that game or sport is conducted for the recreation
or entertainment of the general public, and if no part of the income
or other fund of the society or association is used or available to be
used for the private pecuniary profit of any proprietor, member or
shareholder of it;
(j) Income derived by any society or association whether incorporated
or not, which is, in the opinion of the Treasurer, established
substantially or primarily for the purpose of advertising, beautifying
or developing the island of Niue or any village or district therein so
as to attract trade, tourists, visitors, or population, or to create,
increase, expand or develop amenities for the general public, if no
part of the income or other funds of the society or association is
used or is or may become available to be used for any other purpose,
not being a charitable purpose;
(k) Income derived by any person from any maintenance or allowance
provided for or paid to him in respect of his attendance at an
educational institution in terms of a scholarship or bursary;
(l) Income derived by any person, in respect of any period of incapacity
for work, from any sick pay or other allowance paid to him from
any sick, accident or death benefit fund to which he was a
contributor at the date of commencement of that period of
incapacity;
920 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(m) Income derived by any trustee in trust for any sickness, accident, or death benefit fund, not being income derived directly or indirectly from any business carried on by or on behalf of or for the benefit of that trustee;
(n) Income expressly exempted from income tax by any other Act to the extent of the exemption so provided;
(o) Moneys received by a wife from her husband or a husband from his wife;
(p) Income derived by any life insurance company in so far as that
income is derived from life insurance premiums;
(q) Income and profits derived by any cooperative society registered
under the Cooperative Societies Regulations 1953;
(r) Income derived from any bonds or securities issued exempt from
tax by the Government or by any local or public authority:
Provided that the approval of the Government has been obtained for the issue of
the bonds or other securities to be issued exempt from tax;
(s) Income of the South Pacific Commission and the income in so far
as it is derived from the funds of the South Pacific Commission of
persons employed by the Commission;
(t) Income of the United Nations or of any specialised agency of the
United Nations and the income in so far as it is derived from the
funds of the United Nations or any such agency of persons
employed by the United Nations or any such agency;
(u) Such allowances or class or classes of allowances as Cabinet may
declare to be exempt from taxation either wholly or in part;
(v) Income derived by any person from any pension or benefit granted
to him under the Pensions and Benefits Act 1991;
(w) Income drived by the Niue Bank;
(x) Income derived from a periodic payment by way of superannuation,
pension, retiring allowance or annuity in respect of or in relation to
past employment of that person or any person of whom that person
is or has been the wife, or husband, or a child or dependent.
(2) For the purposes of this section “sickness, accident, or death benefit
fund” means any fund established for the benefit of the employees of any employer
or of the members of any incorporated society or for the benefit of the widows
and dependants of any deceased employees of any employer, or of any deceased
members of any incorporated society, and approved for the time being by the
Treasurer.

Assessable Income and Deductions

50 Exemptions in respect of industries contributing to economic

development

(1) Where any new industry or enterprise is established in Niue or where
any industry or enterprise already existing in Niue is materially expanded, and
where Cabinet is satisfied that such establishment or expansion as the case may
be will contribute substantially to the economic development of Niue, Cabinet
may grant to the enterprise, or to the person or persons contributing to the
establishment or expansion of that industry or enterprise such concessions in
respect of taxation on the income derived whether directly or indirectly from that
industry or enterprise as may be specified by Cabinet.

Income Tax Act 1961

921
(2) Concessions granted by Cabinet under the authority of this section may take the form of exemption of all or part of the income from taxation, reduction in the rates of taxation on all or part of the income, extension of the period during which losses may be carried forward, allowance of special deductions from assessable income, or may be in such other form as Cabinet considers desirable and appropriate to the particular application.
(3) A grant made under this section shall specify the period (not exceeding
5 years) during which any concession is to apply, and the period as specified may
be extended by Cabinet.
(4) Any grant made under this section may be made upon or subject to
such conditions as Cabinet thinks fit and may at any time be revoked by Cabinet
if the taxpayer fails to comply with any such conditions.

51 Items included in assessable income

Without in any way limiting the meaning of the term, the assessable income
of any person shall for the purposes of this Act be deemed to include, save so far as express provision is made in this Act to the contrary, all income derived from the following sources –
(a) All profits or gains derived from any business (including any increase in the value of stock in hand at the time of the transfer or sale of the business, or on the reconstruction of a company);
(b) All salaries, wages, or allowances (whether in cash or otherwise), including all sums received or receivable by way of bonus, gratuity, extra salary, or emolument of any kind, in respect of or in relation to the employment or service of the taxpayer:
Provided that where any bonus, gratuity, or retiring allowance (not being moneys paid to any director of a company pursuant to its articles of association) is paid in a lump sum in respect of the employment or service of the taxpayer on the occasion of his retirement from such employment or service only 5 per cent of that lump sum shall be deemed to be income; and
Provided also that, without limiting the meaning of “allowance” as used in this paragraph the said term shall be deemed to include (in the case of a taxpayer who in any income year has been provided in respect of any office or position held by him with board or lodging, or the use of a house or quarters, or has been paid an allowance in lieu of being so provided with board or lodging or with the use of a house or quarters the value of such benefits, such value to be determined in case of dispute by the Treasurer, subject to the Treasurer ’s assessment under Part 4: Provided also that the Treasurer may determine whether and to what extent any allowance in respect of or in relation to the employment or service of any person constitutes a reimbursement or expenditure exclusively incurred by him in the production of his assessable income, and the allowance shall to the extent so determined be exempt from income tax, and in such case the determination of the Treasurer shall be final and conclusive, save that the taxpayer may have a right of appeal under section 36 (2);
(c) All profits or gains derived from the sale of other disposition of any real or personal property or any interest therein, if the business of the taxpayer comprises dealing in such property, or if the property was acquired for the purpose of selling or otherwise disposing of it, and all profits or gains derived from the carrying on or carrying out of any undertaking or scheme entered into or devised for the purpose of making a profit;
922 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(d) All rents, fines, premiums, or other revenues (including payments for or in respect of the goodwill of any business, or the benefit of any statutory licence or privilege) derived by the owner of land from any lease, licence, or easement affecting the land or from the grant of any right of taking the profits of it;
(e) All royalties or other like payments dependent upon production
from or the use of any real or personal property, whether or not
they are instalments of the purchase price of any property;
(f) All interests, dividends, annuities and pensions:
Provided that where any securities have been acquired by purchase or otherwise
during the income year, the Treasurer may, where he considers it equitable so to
do, apportion between the transferor and the transferee any interest due or accruing
due at the date of the transfer and not them paid;
(g) Income derived from any other source whatsoever.

52 Income from use or occupation of land

(1) Without limiting section 51(c) the assessable income of any person shall,
for the purposes of this Act, be deemed to include –
(a) All profits or gains derived from the use or occupation of any land;
(b) All profits or gains derived in any income year from the extraction,
removal, or sale of any minerals, or timber whether by the owner
of the land from which they are obtained or by any other person,
reduced by an amount equal to the cost of those minerals or of that
timber.
(2) For the purposes of subsection 1(b) “timber” shall be deemed to include
standing timber, and “sale” shall be deemed to include any dispositions by way
of a licence or easement, or the grant of any right of taking any profits or produce
from land.

53 Income credited in account or otherwise dealt with

For the purposes of this Act every person shall be deemed to have derived
income although it has not been actually paid to or received by him, or already
become due or receivable, but has been credited in account, or re-invested, or
accumulated, or capitalised, or carried to any reserve, sinking or insurance fund,
or otherwise dealt with in his interest or in his behalf.

54 Deductions for repair, maintenance and depreciation

(1) (a) In calculating the assessable income derived by any person from
any source no deduction shall be made in respect of any of the
following sums or matters – the repair of premises, or the repair,
alteration, or supply of implements, utensils, or machinery used in
the production of income, beyond the amount expended in any
year for those purposes.
(b) Where depreciation of such premises, implements, utensils or
machinery, whether caused by fair wear and tear or by the fact of
such premises, implements, utensils, or machinery becoming
obsolete or useless, cannot be made good by repair, the Treasurer
may allow such deductions as he thinks just up to but not exceeding
the rates of depreciation as set out in Schedule 2 except that in the
year in which any implements, utensils, or machinery are disposed
of or discarded, the Treasurer may allow such further deductions
as he thinks just.

Income Tax Act 1961

923
(c) Where the Treasurer has for any year of assessment allowed a deduction in respect of the depreciation of any premises, implements, utensils, or machinery, and the taxpayer at any time afterwards sells such premises, implements, utensils, or machinery at a price in excess of the amount to which the value of those assets has been reduced by such allowance, the Treasurer may make a revised assessment for that or any subsequent year without allowing such deduction or without allowing such portion of it as he thinks fit, and may recover the additional amount of income tax accordingly. For the purpose of giving effect to this proviso the Treasurer may at any time alter any assessment, notwithstanding anything to the contrary in section 20.
(d) Where the Treasurer is satisfied that any repairs or alterations of any plant, premises or machinery do not increase the capital value of the plant, premises or machinery, or that the repairs or alterations increase that value by an amount less than the cost of the repairs or alterations, he may allow such deductions as he thinks just.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1)(c) –
(a) Where any asset has been sold together with other assets of a
business, the part of the consideration attributable to that asset shall
be determined by the Treasurer, and the part of the consideration
so determined shall be deemed to be the price at which that asset
was sold by the vendor and purchased by the purchaser;
(b) Where any property is sold, distributed or otherwise disposed of
without consideration or for a consideration which, in the opinion
of the Treasurer, is less than the market price for the true value of
the property on the day it was sold, distributed or otherwise
disposed of, that property shall be deemed to have been sold at
and to have realised such market price or, if there is no market price,
shall be deemed to have been sold at and to have realised such
price as the Treasurer determines.
(3) It shall be ground for an objection to an assessment of income tax under
Part 4 that any determination of the Treasurer made for the purpose of subsection
(2) is erroneous in fact.
(4) Without limiting the discretion of the Treasurer under subsection (1), it
is hereby declared that he has power to refuse in whole or in part to allow any
deduction under that subsection in any case where he is not satisfied that complete
and satisfactory accounts have been kept by or on behalf of the taxpayer and that
sufficient depreciation has been provided for in the taxpayer ’s accounts.
(5) Sections 58, 61, 62 and 66(3) shall have effect notwithstanding anything
to the contrary in this section and sections 56 and 57.

55 Deductions in respect of buildings on Niuean leaseholds

(1) The Treasurer, in calculating the assessable income derived by any
taxpayer during any income year, may allow such deductions as he thinks fit in respect of any sum expanded by the taxpayer –
(a) In acquiring or erecting any building on any Niuean freehold land
which the taxpayer holds on lease; or
(b) In purchasing the unexpired period of any lease of Niuean freehold
land.
924

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(2) (a) In ascertaining the amount that may be deducted under this section in respect of any income year, the amount expended by the taxpayer in respect of the acquisition or erection of the building or in respect of the purchase of the lease shall be apportioned by the Treasurer over the unexpired period of the lease (including any period in respect of which a right of renewal exists) calculated from the date of the acquisition or erection or purchase as the case may be and the amount deducted in respect of any income year shall not in any case exceed the amount apportioned to that year.
(b) In ascertaining the amount to be deducted the Treasurer shall take into account the amount by which the value of any building has already been reduced by the allowance of depreciation under the provisions of corresponding New Zealand legislation relating to the payment of income tax.
(c) Where the unexpired portion of a lease is sold to any company over
which the vendor has control as defined by section 75 or to any
partnership over which the vendor has control the amount of the
annual deductions shall be limited to the amount by which the
vendor would have been entitled had the sale not taken place.
(3) Where the Treasurer has, for any year of assessment, allowed a
deduction under this section and the taxpayer at any time afterwards sells the
unexpired period of the lease, the Treasurer may make a revised assessment in
respect of that year of assessment without allowing that deduction or without
allowing such portion of it as he thinks fit, and may recover the additional amount
of income tax accordingly.
(4) For the purpose of giving effect to subsection (3) the Treasurer may at
any time alter any assessment, notwithstanding section 20.
(5) For the purposes of this section, where the unexpired period of the
lease has been sold together with other assets of a business the consideration
attributable to the sale of the lease and of any buildings erected on the demised
land shall be determined by the Treasurer, and the part of the consideration so
determined shall be deemed to be the price at which the lease and buildings were
sold by the vendor and purchased by the purchaser.
(6) A taxpayer to whom this section applies may elect whether he will
claim a deduction hereunder or will claim a deduction for depreciation under
section 54, but any deduction made under this section shall be in substitution for
any deduction for depreciation which may be allowable under section 54.

56 Other deductions not permitted from assessable income

In calculating the assessable income derived by any person from any source,
no deduction except as expressly provided in this Act shall be made in respect of any of the following sums or matters –
(a) Investments, expenditure, loss, or withdrawal of capital; money used or intended to be used as capital; money used in the improvement of premises occupied; interest which might have been made on such capital or money if laid out at interest;
(b) Bad debts, except debts which are proved to the satisfaction of the
Treasurer to be in fact bad and to have been actually written off as
bad debts by the tax payer in the income year;
Provided that all amounts at any time received on account of any
such bad debt shall be credited as income in the year in which they
are received, and shall be subject to tax accordingly:

Income Tax Act 1961

925
Provided further that if in the opinion of the Treasurer the amount of debts written off as bad in any income year is excessive, he may, notwithstanding section 20, reopen the assessments made in any previous years in which he considers that the debts had in fact become bad;
(c) Any expenditure or loss recoverable under any insurance or contract
of indemnity;
(d) Payments of any kind made by a husband to his wife or by a wife
to her husband;
(e) Rent of any dwelling house or domestic offices, save that, so far as
such dwelling house or offices are used in the production of the
assessable income, the Treasurer may allow a deduction of such
proportion of the rent as he may think just and reasonable;
(f) Income tax;
(g) Interest, except so far as the Treasurer is satisfied that it is payable
on capital employed in the production of the assessable income.

57 Deduction of expenditure or loss from income

(1) (a) In calculating the assessable income of any person deriving such
income from one source only, any expenditure or loss exclusively
incurred in the production of the assessable income for any income
year may except as expressly provided in this Act be deducted from
the total income derived for that Act.
(b) In calculating the assessable income of any person deriving such
income from 2 or more sources, any expenditure or loss exclusively
incurred in the production of assessable income for any income
year may except as expressly provided in this Act be deducted from
the total income derived by the taxpayer for that year from all such
sources as aforesaid.
(2) In calculating the non-assessable income of any person any expenditure
or loss exclusively incurred in the production of the non-assessable income for
any income year may be deducted from such income derived for that year. Any
such expenditure or loss deductible under this subsection shall be determined in
the same manner as if the non-assessable income was assessable.
(3) Except as expressly provided in this Act no deduction shall be made in
respect of any expenditure or loss of any kind for the purpose of calculating the
assessable income of any taxpayer.

58 Losses incurred may be set off against future profits

(1) For the purpose of this section any loss incurred by a taxpayer shall be
ascertained under this Act for the calculation of assessable income.
(2) (a) Any taxpayer who satisfies the Treasurer that he has in any year
incurred a loss shall be entitled to claim that such loss be carried
forward, and, so far as may be, deducted from or set off against his
income for the 6 years succeeding the year in which the loss was
incurred.
(b) No claim to a deduction or set-off will be allowed under this section
in respect of any loss which has been deducted from or set-off
against the assessable income of the taxpayer under the provisions
of the corresponding New Zealand legislation relating to income
tax.
926

59

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(c) Any relief under this section shall be given so far as possible from the first succeeding assessment, and so far as it cannot then be given, shall be given from the next succeeding assessment, and so on.
(d) In no case shall a loss of assessable income be set off against non- assessable income nor shall a loss of non-assessable income be set off against assessable income.
(e) (i) Where, if a profit has been made from the transaction in which the loss was incurred, the amount of the profit would have been assessable or non-assessable income as the case may be, no relief shall be given under this section in respect of that loss.
(ii) Where, if a profit had been made as aforesaid, the amount of the profit would have been assessable or non-assessable income, the amount of the loss carried forward to any year shall be deducted from or set off against the taxpayer ’s assessable or non-assessable income, as the case may be, for that year so far as that income extends.
(3) (a) Notwithstanding subsections (1) and (2) if in any year of assessment any taxpayer, being a company, claims to carry forward any loss made by it in any former income year, the claim shall not be allowed unless the Treasurer is satisfied that the shareholders of the company on the balance date of the company for the year to which the loss claimed is to be carried forward were substantially the same as the shareholders of the company on the balance date of the company for the year in which the loss was incurred.
(b) For the purposes of this subsection the shareholders of a company at any date shall not be deemed to be substantially the same as the shareholders on any other date unless, on both such dates, not less than two-thirds in nominal value of the allotted shares in such company were held by or on behalf of the same persons.
(c) For the purposes of this subsection shares in a company held by or on behalf of another company shall be deemed to be held by the shareholders of such last mentioned company and shares held by or on behalf of the trustee of the estate of a deceased shareholder, or by or on behalf of the persons entitled to those shares as beneficiaries under the will or intestacy of a deceased shareholder, shall be deemed to be held by that deceased shareholder.

Amounts remitted to be taken into account in computing income

(1) Where the amount of any expenditure or loss incurred by a taxpayer
has been taken into account in calculating his assessable income for any income year, and subsequently the liability of the taxpayer in respect of that amount is remitted in whole or in part, the assessable income derived by the taxpayer during that year shall be deemed to be increased by the amount so remitted, and the taxpayer shall be assessable and liable for income tax accordingly.
(2) Where the amount of any expenditure or loss incurred by a taxpayer has been taken into account in calculating for the purposes of section 58 the amount of any loss incurred by him in any income year, and subsequently the liability of the taxpayer in respect of that amount has been remitted in whole or in part, the amount of the loss that may be carried forward under section 58 shall be deemed to be reduced by the amount so remitted.

Income Tax Act 1961

927
(3) For the purposes of this section a liability in respect of any expenditure or loss shall be deemed to have been remitted to the extent to which the taxpayer has been discharged from that liability without fully adequate consideration in money or money’s worth.
(4) For the purposes of giving effect to this section, the Treasurer may at any time alter any assessment, notwithstanding section 20.

60 Apportionment of income received in anticipation

(1) When income is derived by any person in any year by way of fines,
premiums, or payment for goodwill on the grant of a lease, or in any other like
manner by way of anticipation, the Treasurer may at the request of that person
during the next succeeding year, apportion that income between the income year
and any number of subsequent years not exceeding 5, and the part so apportioned
to each of those years shall be deemed to have been derived in that year, and shall
be assessable for income tax accordingly.
(2) Any such apportionment may be at any time cancelled by the Treasurer,
and thereupon the income so apportioned or the part of it on which income tax
has not yet been paid shall become assessable for income tax as if derived during
the year preceding that in which the apportionment was so cancelled.

61 Expenditure incurred in borrowing money or obtaining lease

The Treasurer may, in calculating the assessable income of any taxpayer,
allow such deduction as he thinks fit in respect of expenditure incurred by the
taxpayer during the income year for the preparation, stamping, and registration
of any lease of property used in the production of his assessable income, or of any
renewal of such lease, or in borrowing of money employed by the taxpayer as
capital in the production of assessable income.

62 Deduction in respect of premium paid on account of leased machinery

(1) The Treasurer may, in calculating the assessable income of any taxpayer,
allow such deduction as he thinks fit in respect of any premium, fine, or foregift,
or any consideration in the nature of a premium, fine, or foregift, paid by the
taxpayer in respect of the lease of any machinery used by him in the production of
income, or in respect of the renewal of any such lease, or in respect of the assignment
of transfer of any such lease.
(2) In ascertaining the amount that may be deducted in any year under
this section the total amount paid by the taxpayer as aforesaid shall be apportioned
by the Treasurer over the period of the lease unexpired at the date of payment,
and the amount deducted for any year shall not in any case exceed the amount
apportioned to that year.

63 Income derived from disposal of trading stock

(1) Where any trading stock is sold together with other assets of a business
the part of the consideration attributable to the trading stock shall, for the purposes
of this Act, be determined by the Treasurer, and the part of the consideration so
determined shall be deemed to be the price paid for the trading stock by the
purchaser.
(2) For the purpose of this section any trading stock which has been
disposed of otherwise than by sale shall be deemed to have been sold, and any
trading stock so disposed of and any trading stock which has been sold for a
consideration other than cash shall be deemed to have realised the market price
of the day on which it was so disposed of or sold, but, where there is no market
price, trading stock shall be deemed to have realised such price as the Treasurer
determines.
928

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(3) For the purposes of this section “trading stock” includes anything produced or manufactured and anything acquired or purchased for purposes of manufacture, sale or exchange; and also includes any other real or personal property sold or disposed of by the taxpayer where the business of the taxpayer comprises dealing in such property or the property was acquired by him for the purpose of sale or other disposal; and also includes livestock.
(4) It shall be grounds for objection to an assessment of income tax under Part 4 that any determination of the Treasurer made for the purpose of this section is erroneous in fact.

64 Valuation of trading stock, including livestock

(1) For the purposes of this Act “trading stock” includes anything produced
or manufactured, and anything acquired or purchased for purpose of manufacture, sale or exchange and also includes livestock but does not include land.
(2) Where any taxpayer owns or carries on any business the value of his
trading stock at the beginning and at the end of every income year shall be taken
into account in ascertaining whether or not he has derived assessable income
during that year.
(3) (a) The value of the trading stock of any taxpayer to be taken into
account at the beginning of any income year shall be its value as at
the end of the last preceding income year.
(b) Where the taxpayer ’s business is commenced and his trading stock
is acquired during the income year the value of the trading stock as
at the beginning of the income year shall be deemed to be an amount
equal to its cost price.
(4) The value of the trading stock of any taxpayer to be taken into account,
at the end of any income year shall be, at the option of the taxpayer, its cost price,
its market selling value, or the price at which it can be replaced.
(5) Where the value of the trading stock of any taxpayer at the beginning
of any income year exceeds the value of his trading stock at the end of that year
the amount of the excess shall be allowed as a deduction in computing the
assessable income of the taxpayer for that year.
(6) Where the value of the trading stock of any taxpayer at the beginning
of any income year exceeds the value of his trading stock at the end of that year
the amount of the excess shall be allowed as a deduction in computing the
assessable income of the taxpayer for that year.
(7) Where in any income year the whole or any part of the assets of a
business owned or carried on by any taxpayer is sold or otherwise disposed of
(whether by way of exchange, or gift, or distribution in terms of a will, or on an
intestacy, or otherwise howsoever, and whether or not in the ordinary course of
the business of the taxpayer or for the purpose of putting an end to that business
or any part of it), and the assets sold or otherwise disposed of consist of or include
any trading stock the consideration received or receivable for the trading stock or
(if any case where section 62 or 64 applies) the price which under that section the
trading stock is deemed to have realised shall be taken into account in computing
the taxpayer ’s assessable income for that year or for any subsequent income year,
be deemed to have purchased it at the amount of that consideration or price.
(8) Subject to sections 62 and 64, the price specified in any contract of sale
or arrangement as the price at which any trading stock is sold or otherwise disposed
of as aforesaid shall be deemed for the purposes of this section to be the
consideration received or receivable for the trading stock.
(9) Notwithstanding subsections (1) to (8) the value of trading stock on
hand at the beginning of the first income year to which the provisions of this Act
are applicable shall be deemed to be an amount equal to its cost price.

Income Tax Act 1961

929

65 Sale of trading stock for inadequate consideration

(1) Where any trading stock is sold or otherwise disposed of without
consideration in money or money’s worth or for a consideration that is less than
each of –
(i) the cost price of the trading stock; and
(ii) the market price on the day of the sale or other disposition or
where there is no market price, such price as the Treasurer
determines (referred to below as “the market price”),
the following provisions shall apply, namely –
(a) The trading stock shall be deemed for the purposes of this Act to
have been sold at and to have realised the cost price or the market
price, whichever is the lower;
(b) The price which under this section the trading stock is deemed to
have realised shall be taken into account in calculating the assessable
income of the person selling or otherwise disposing of the trading
stock;
(c) The person acquiring the trading stock shall, for the purpose of
calculating his assessable income, be deemed to have purchased
the trading stock at the price which under this section the trading
stock is deemed to have realised.
(2) It shall be grounds for objection to an assessment of income tax that
any determination of the Treasurer made for the purposes of this section is
erroneous in fact.
(3) For the purposes of this section “trading stock” includes anything
produced or manufactured, and anything acquired or purchased for purposes of
manufacture, sale or exchange, and also includes livestock and also includes any
other real or personal property where the business of the person by whom it is
sold or disposed or comprises dealing in such property or the property was
acquired by him for the purpose of sale or other disposal.

66 Assessment and deduction of patent rights and expenses, and trade mark renewals

(1) For the purposes of this section “patent rights” means the right to do or authorise the doing of anything which would, but for that right, be an infringement of a patent.
(2) Where any taxpayer sells any patent rights, any sum received by him or owing to him in respect of the sale or such part thereof as the Treasurer considers just and reasonable shall be deemed to be assessable income and shall be assessed for income tax in such manner as the Treasurer determines.
(3) The Treasurer, in calculating the assessable income derived by any taxpayer during any income year, may allow such deduction as he thinks fit in respect of any sum expended by the taxpayer on the purchase of any patent rights or any expenditure incurred by him in the grant, maintenance or extension of a patent or in the renewal of any registration of any trade mark or trade name used by him in the production of his assessable income for that year.

67 Deduction for scientific research

In calculating the assessable income derived by any taxpayer during any
income year, the Treasurer may allow such deduction as he thinks fit in respect of
any expenditure incurred by the taxpayer during that year in connection with
scientific research directly relating to the trade or business carried on by the
taxpayer, except so far as the expenditure relates to an asset in respect of which a
deduction for depreciation is allowable under section 54(1).
930 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

68 Deduction of testamentary annuities charged on property

(1) (a) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained elsewhere in
this Act, where property has been devised or bequeathed by will
subject to the payment of an annuity or has been made subject to
the payment of an annuity by a deed of family arrangement, and
that property or any property substituted therefor has been
transferred to a beneficiary and is charged with payment of the
annuity or any part thereof, the amount paid in any income year
on account of that annuity by the owner of that property or
substituted property shall be allowed as a deduction in calculating
the income derived by the owner from that property or substituted
property in that income year so far as that income extends.
(b) No deduction shall be allowed under this section where the owner
for the time being of the property or substituted property (not being
a beneficiary) is a person who has acquired the same by purchase
subject to the condition that he assumes the liability for the whole
or any part of the annuity charged thereon.
(c) To the extent that an annuity payable by the owner of the property
or substituted property under a deed of family arrangement
represents, in the opinion of the Treasurer, consideration for the
purchase of the property or substituted property by the owner, the
annuity shall not be allowed as a deduction under this section.
(2) In this section “beneficiary”, in relation to any property, means a person
to whom that property has been devised or bequeathed by will, or a person who
is entitled, pursuant to a provision in a will, to purchase, subject to payment of an
annuity, that property, being property that forms part of the estate of the testator;
and includes a person who is entitled to the property pursuant to a deed of family
arrangement.

69 Contributions to employees’ superannuation fund

(1) (a) In calculating the taxable income of any employer the Treasurer
may allow a deduction of any amount set aside or paid by the
employer as or to a fund to provide individual personal benefits,
pensions, or retiring allowances to employees of that employer.
(b) A deduction shall not be allowed under this section unless the
Treasurer is satisfied that the fund has been established or the
payment made in such a manner that the rights of the employees
to receive the benefits, pensions or retiring allowances have been
fully secured.
(2) The Treasurer shall have a discretion as to whether or not a deduction
should be allowed under subsection (1) of the whole or any part of any amount
set aside or paid as mentioned in that subsection.

70 Treasurer may make arrangements, for first three income years

It is hereby declared that subject to this Act the Treasurer may in respect of
the first income years of any person to whom this Act becomes applicable, make
such arrangements, compromises, or calculations as he sees fit, in the assessment
of income derived by that person during those years, and may make such
assessments of income tax as he sees fit to give effect to such arrangements,
compromises or calculations.

Income Tax Act 1961

931

Provisions relating to Companies and Associations

71 Profits of mutual associations in respect of transactions with members

(1) Where an association enters into transactions with its members, or with
its members and others, any profit or surplus arising from those transactions which
would be included in the profits or gains of the association if the transactions
were not of a mutual character shall be deemed to be profits or gains arising from
those transactions and to be assessable income of the association except that, in
computing the assessable income of the association the Treasurer shall allow as
expenses any sums which –
(a) Represent a discount, rebate, dividend, or bonus granted or paid
by the association to members or other persons in respect of amounts
paid or payable by or to them on account of their transactions with
the association, being transactions which are taken into account in
computing the assessable income; and
(b) Are calculated by reference to the said amounts or to the magnitude
of the said transactions and not by reference to any share or interest
in the capital of the association.
(2) Where any discount, rebate, dividend, or bonus is granted or paid to
any person by an association, it shall form part of the assessable income of that
person if the transaction from which it arises is of such a nature that any payment
in respect of it by that person to the association would be allowed as a deduction
in computing the assessable income of that person.
(3) For the purpose of this section, a discount, rebate, dividend or bonus
shall be deemed to have been granted to or paid to a person when it has been
credited in account or otherwise dealt with in his interest or on his behalf.
(4) In this section “association” includes any body or association of persons,
whether incorporated or not, other than those mentioned in section 49(1)(q).

72 Overseas insurance companies other than life insurance companies

(1) For the purpose of this Act the assessable income of an overseas
insurance company shall include the amount of gross premiums derived by the
company in respect of business (other than life assurance business) transacted in
Niue.
(2) Income tax on the assessable income of an overseas insurance company determined in accordance with subsection (1), shall be assessed at the rate as set out in Schedule 1.
(3) “Overseas insurance company” for the purposes of this section means a company mainly carrying on the business of insurance or guarantee against loss, damage or risk of any kind whatever whose main place of business is situated outside Niue.

73 Companies with substantially the same shareholders or under the same control

(1) If the Treasurer is satisfied with respect to 2 or more companies consisting substantially of the same shareholders or under control of the same persons, that the separate constitution or the separate continuance of those companies is not exclusively for the purpose of more effectively carrying out their objects but is wholly or partly for the purpose of reducing their taxation, the Treasurer may, for the purposes of income tax, treat those companies as if they were a single company, and in any such case those companies shall be jointly assessed and jointly and severally liable with such right of contribution or indemnity between themselves as is just.
(2) Section 75(2) and (3) shall be deemed to be also applicable to this section.
932 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

74 Liability of new companies for tax payable by former companies with substantially the same shareholders or under the same control

(1) In this section –
“company” means a Niue company or an overseas company within the
meaning of this Act;
“new company” means a company carrying on business in Niue and
consisting substantially of the same shareholders as an original
company or being under the control of the same persons as an original
company;
“original company” means a company which having at any time carried
on business in Niue has, ceased to carry on business in Niue, and
includes any such company that has been wound up.
(2) For the purposes of this section, a new company shall be deemed to
consist substantially of the same shareholders as an original company if not less
than one half of the paid up capital of the new company is held by or on behalf of
shareholders in the original company. Shares in one company held by or on behalf
of another company shall for the purposes of this subsection be deemed to be
held by the shareholders in the last mentioned company.
(3) Where an original company within the meaning of this section has been
wound up its shareholders and directors, as on the commencement of its winding
up, shall respectively be deemed to be the shareholders and the persons having
the control of the company for the purposes of this section.
(4) Where an original company as hereinbefore defined was, when it ceased
to carry on business in Niue liable under this Act for any income tax or was liable
to be assessed for any such tax, and such tax has not been paid, the new company
shall, for the purposes of this Act, be deemed to be the agent of the original company
and shall be liable for all tax payable by the original company. It shall also be
liable for all tax for which the original company would have been liable if it had
continued to carry on business in Niue.

75 Defining when a company is under the control of any persons

(1) For the purposes of this Act except where otherwise expressly provided
a company shall be deemed to be under the control of the person –
(a) By whom more than one half of the shares, or more than one half of
the nominal capital, or more than one half of the paid up capital, or
more than one half of the voting power is held, or;
(b) Who have by any other means whatsoever control of the company;
or
(c) Who by reason of the shareholding at the end of any income year
would be entitled to more than one half of the profits for that year
if those profits were distributed by way of dividend at the end of
that year.
(2) For the purposes of this Act, 2 companies shall be deemed to consist
substantially of the same shareholders if not less than one half of the paid up
capital of each of them is held by shareholders in the other or if not less than one
half in nominal value of the allotted shares in each of them is held by shareholders
in the other. Shares in one company held by another company shall for this purpose
be deemed to be held by the shareholders in the last mentioned company.
(3) Where a nominee of any person holds any shares, nominal capital, paid
up capital, or voting power in a company, or has by any other means whatsoever
any power of control in a company, or is entitled to a share of profits distributed
by a company, then for the purposes of this section those shared or that capital or

Income Tax Act 1961

933
that voting power or that power of control or that title to profits, as the case may be, shall be deemed to be held by that person, and in every such case that person and his nominee or that person and all his nominees shall be deemed to be one person.
(4) In this section –
“nominee”, in relation to any person, means any other person who may be
required to exercise his voting power in relation to any company in
accordance with the direction of that person, or who holds shares or
debentures directly or indirectly on behalf of that person; and includes
the husband or wife of that person and any relatives of that person by
blood, marriage, or adoption;
“person” includes a company and a local or public authority.

76 Floating rate of interest on debentures

(1) Where in any debenture issued by a company the rate of interest payable
is not specifically determined, but is determinable from time to time by reference
to the dividend payable by the company or otherwise howsoever, the interest
paid on the debenture shall be considered part of the assessable income of the
company and not of the debenture holder.
(2) Section 100 shall not apply with respect to any such debenture or to the
interest paid or payable thereunder.

77 Interest on debentures issued in substitution for shares

(1) For the purposes of this section –
(a) “The amount of the debenture” means, in respect of any debenture,
the principal sum expressed to be secured by or owing under that
debenture;
(b) “Shareholder” includes, in respect of any company, a person by
whom or on whose behalf shares in the company have at any time
been held.
(2) Where a company has issued debentures to its shareholders or to any
class of its shareholders, and the amount of the debenture or debentures issued to
each shareholder of the company or of that class has been determined by reference
to the number or to the nominal value or to the paid up value of, or by reference
otherwise howsoever to the shares in that company or in any other company
(whether or not that other company is being or has been wound up) that were
held by or on behalf of the shareholder at the time the debentures were issued or
at any earlier time, the interest paid by the company on the debentures so issued
shall be computed as part of the assessable income of the company and not of the
debenture holder.
(3) The provisions of section 76 and of any other enactment shall apply
with respect to all debentures to which subsection (2) applies and to the interest
payable thereunder, in the same manner as if those debentures and that interest
were debentures and interest of the kinds referred to in section 76.

78 Payment of excessive remuneration or share of profits to relatives in certain cases

(1) Where –
(a) Any taxpayer carries on any business or undertaking and employs
or engages any relatives of a director or shareholder of the company
to perform services in connection with that business or undertaking;
or
934 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) Any taxpayer carries on business in partnership with any person, whether or not any other person is a member of the partnership, and –
(i) any relative of the taxpayer is employed or engaged by the partnership to perform services in connection with the business; or
(ii) where one of the partners is a company, any relative of a director or shareholder of the company is employed or engaged by the partnership to perform services in connection with the business; or
(c) Any taxpayer carries on business in partnership with any relative or with any company a director or shareholder of which is a relative of the taxpayer or, being a company, carries on business in partnership with any relative of a director or shareholder of the company whether or not any other person is a member of the partnership –
and the Treasurer is of the opinion that the remuneration, salary, share of profits or other income payable to or for the benefit of that relative or company under the contract of employment or engagement or the terms of the partnership exceeds such an amount as is reasonable having regard to the nature and extent of the services rendered, the value of the contributions made by the respective partners by way of services or capital or otherwise, and any other relevant matters, the Treasurer may for the purposes of this Act allocate the total profits or income of the business or undertaking before deduction of any amount payable to that relative or company between the parties to the contract or the partners or any of them in such shares and proportions as he considers reasonable and the amounts so allocated shall be deemed to be income derived by the person to whom those amounts are so allocated and by no other person.
(2) Where any sum paid or credited by a company, being or purporting to
be remuneration for services rendered by any person who is a relative of a director
or shareholder of the company, is allocated to that company under subsection (1),
the amount so allocated to the company shall be deemed to be a dividend paid by
the company to that person and received by him as a shareholder of the company.
(3) For the purposes of this section “relative” means a husband or wife, or
a relative by blood within the fourth degree of relationship (whether legitimate or
illegitimate), or a relative by marriage or adoption, and includes a trustee for a
relative.
(4) Notwithstanding section 35(1) it shall be grounds for objection under
Part 4 to an assessment of income tax that any determination of the Treasurer
made for the purposes of this section is erroneous and the Collector or the Court,
as the case may be hearing the objection, shall have power to review the
determination of the Treasurer, and shall for that purpose have all the powers and
functions of the Treasurer in making that determination, and the decision of the
Court shall except for the purposes of objection thereto take effect as if it were the
determination of the Treasurer; but nothing in this subsection shall restrict the
right of the Treasurer or the objector to appeal against the decision of the Court
under Part 4.
(5) [Spent]
(6) This section shall not apply to a bona fide contract of employment or to
a bona fide contract of partnership. For the purposes of this section a contract of
employment or a contract of partnership shall be deemed to be bona fide if it
complies with the following conditions –

Income Tax Act 1961

935
(a) The contract is in writing or by deed signed by all the parties hereto; (b) No partner and no person employed or engaged under the contract was under the age of 21 years at the date on which the contract was
signed;
(c) The contract is binding on the parties to it for a term of not less than
3 years and is not capable of being terminated by any party thereto
before the expiry of that term;
(d) Each party to the contract has a real and effective control of the
remuneration, salary, share of profits, or other income to which he
is entitled under the contract;
(e) The remuneration, salary, share of profits, or other income payable
to a relative, or to a company, a director or shareholder of which is
a relative, is not of such an amount that the transaction would
constitute in whole or in part a gift for gift duties purposes if the
Estate and Gift Duties Act 1968 (NZ) were in force in Niue.

79 Excessive remuneration by company to shareholder or director

Where any sum paid or credited by a company, being or purporting to be
remuneration for services rendered by any person who is a shareholder or director
of the company, exceeds such amount as in the opinion of the Treasurer is
reasonable, the amount of the excess shall not be an allowable deduction in
computing the assessable income of the company, and shall for the purposes of
this Act be deemed to be a dividend paid by the company to that person and
received by him as a shareholder of the company.

Country of Derivation of Income

80 Liability for assessment of income derived from Niue and abroad

(1) Subject to this Act all income derived by any person who is resident in
Niue at the time when he derives that income shall be assessable for income tax
whether it is derived from Niue or from elsewhere.
(2) Subject to this Act, all income derived from Niue shall be assessable for
income tax, whether the person deriving that income is resident in Niue or
elsewhere.
(3) Subject to this Act, income which is neither derived from Niue nor
derived by a person then resident in Niue shall not be assessable for income tax.

81 Place of residence, how determined

(1) A person other than a company shall be deemed to be resident in Niue
within the meaning of this Part if his home is in Niue.
(2) A company shall be deemed to be resident in Niue within the meaning
of this Part if it –
(a) Is incorporated in Niue; or
(b) Has its Head Office in Niue.
(3) The Head Office of a company means the centre of its administrative
management.

82 Classes of income deemed to be derived from Niue

Subject to section 83, the following classes of income shall be deemed to be
derived from Niue –
(a) Income derived from any business carried on in Niue;
(b) All salaries, wages, allowances and emoluments of any kind earned
in Niue in the service of any employer or principal, whether resident
in Niue or elsewhere;
936 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(c) Income derived by any person as the owner of land in Niue;
(d) Income derived by any person from money lent or used in Niue
(whether on security or otherwise)
(e) Income derived from shares in or membership of a Niue company,
or from debentures issued by a Niue company or by a local or public
authority;
(f) Income derived from debentures or other securities issued by the
Administration, or from any contract made with that
Administration;
(g) Any pension or annuity payable by the Administration, or out of
any superannuation fund established in Niue;
(h) Income derived from the sale or other disposition of any property,
corporeal or incorporeal, situated in Niue;
(i) Income derived by a beneficiary under any trust, so far as the income
of the trust fund is derived from Niue;
(j) Income derived from contracts made or wholly or partly performed
in Niue;
(k) Income derived from the carriage by sea or by air of merchandise,
mails, or passengers shipped or embarked in Niue;
(l) Income derived directly or indirectly from any other source in Niue.

83 Apportionment where income derived partly in Niue and partly elsewhere

Whenever by reason of the manufacture, production or purchase of goods in one country and their sale in another, or by reason of successive steps of production or manufacture in different countries, or by reason of the making of contracts in one country and their performance in another, or for any other reason whatever the source of any income is not exclusively in Niue, that income shall be apportioned between its source in Niue and its source elsewhere, or attributed to one of such sources to the exclusion of the other in such manner as the Treasurer thinks just and reasonable, having regard to the nature and relative importance of the sources of that income; and the income so far as so apportioned or attributed to a source in Niue shall be deemed to be derived from Niue and shall be assessable for income tax accordingly.

84 Relief from double taxation

(1) Income derived by a person resident in Niue but not derived from Niue
shall be exempt from income tax if and so far as the Treasurer is satisfied that it is
derived from some other country or territory and that it is chargeable with income
tax in that country or territory.
(2) In determining the country or territory from which income is derived
the Treasurer shall apply the same rules, with the necessary modifications, as are
applicable in determining whether income is derived from Niue.
(3) In this section “income tax” means in respect of any country or territory
other than Niue, any tax which in the opinion of the Treasurer is substantially of
the same nature as income tax under this Act.

85 Arrangements for relief from double taxation

(1) Cabinet may enter into arrangements with the Government of any
country or territory outside Niue with a view to affording relief from double
taxation in relation to income tax or any taxes of a similar character imposed by
the laws of the country or territory and such arrangements shall notwithstanding

Income Tax Act 1961

937
this Act have effect in relation to income tax and every such arrangement shall, subject to the provisions of this section, have effect under its tenor.
(2) Without limiting the generality of the foregoing provisions it is hereby declared that any arrangements which effect is given under this section may contain provision in relation to any of those taxes –
(a) For relief from tax;
(b) For charging the income derived from any sources in Niue to
persons not resident in Niue;
(c) For determining the income to be attributed to persons not resident
in Niue and their agencies, branches or establishment in Niue;
(d) For determining the income to be attributed to persons resident in
Niue who have special relationships with persons not so resident.
(3) Any such arrangements may include provisions as to income which is
not in itself subject to double taxation.
(4) Any arrangements entered into under this section may at any time be
amended or revoked.
(5) Where any arrangements are made under this section the obligation as
to secrecy imposed by this Act shall not prevent the Treasurer from disclosing to
any authorised officer of the Government with which the arrangements are made
such information as is required to be disclosed under the arrangements.

Income derived by a Trustee

86 Special provisions with respect to trustees

With respect to income derived by a trustee the following provisions shall
apply –
(a) If and so far as the income of the trustee is also income derived by a beneficiary entitled in possession to the receipt of it under the trust, the trustee shall in respect of it be deemed to be the agent of that beneficiary, and shall be assessable and liable for income tax thereon accordingly, and all the provisions of this Act as to agents shall, so far as applicable, apply accordingly. Where any income is derived by a beneficiary as aforesaid subject to a condition, obligation, or trust requiring him to maintain or support any other person (whether out of the income so derived or otherwise) and that beneficiary would, apart from that condition, obligation or trust, be entitled to a special exemption in respect of the maintenance and support provided by him for that other person, that beneficiary shall be assessed for income tax and shall be entitled to the same special exemptions as if he were beneficially entitled to the income free from any such condition, obligation, or trust;
(b) If and so far as the income of the trustee is not also income derived
by any beneficiary as aforesaid, the trustee shall be assessable and
liable for income tax on that income in the same manner as if he
was beneficially entitled to it, save that the rate of tax shall be
computed by reference to that income alone, and that the trustee
shall not be entitled to any deduction by way of special exemption,
and that no tax shall be payable if the assessable income does not
exceed $100, and that the amount of tax payable in any case shall,
where necessary, be reduced so as not to exceed the amount by
which the assessable income exceeds $100:
Provided that in any case where a trustee is required or is empowered at his discretion to pay or apply income derived by him to or for the benefit of specified
938 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
beneficiaries or to or for the benefit of some one or more of a number of specified beneficiaries, or of a specified class of beneficiaries, a beneficiary in whose favour the trustee so pays or applies income shall be deemed to be entitled in possession to the receipt of the amount paid to him or applied for his benefit by the trustee under the trust:
Provided also that where the income of the trustee is also income derived by any
beneficiary who is an infant but whose interest in that income is vested, the
beneficiary shall for the purposes of this section be deemed to be entitled in
possession to the receipt of that income under the trust;
(c) The trustee shall in every case make a return of the whole income
so derived by him as trustee, and each such return shall be separate
and distinct from any return of income derived by him under any
other trust or in his own right;
(d) Nothing in this section shall be so construed as to exempt a
beneficiary from any income tax which would be payable by him
had he derived the income to which he is entitled under the trust
directly instead of through a trustee;
(e) Where any company or corporation is a trustee any income
assessable to the trustee under paragraph (b) shall be assessable at
the rate applicable to a trustee other than a company or a
corporation.

87 Income received by trustee after death of deceased person

It is hereby declared that any amount received in any income year by the
trustee of the estate of a deceased person shall be deemed to be assessable or (as
the case may require) non-assessable income derived by the trustee in that year if
it does not represent assessable or non-assessable income derived by the deceased
person during his lifetime but would have been included in his assessable or non-
assessable income if he had been alive when it was received.

88 Deduction from estate income of irrecoverable book debts of deceased taxpayer

Where the amount of any debt owing to a deceased taxpayer at the date of his death has been included in the assessable income of the taxpayer or of the trustee of his estate for any income year, and the debt or any part of it is proved to the satisfaction of the Treasurer to be irrevocable and to have been actually written off by the trustee as a bad debt, the amount so written off shall be deemed to be a loss incurred by the trustee in the income year in which the amount was written off, and shall be allowable as a deduction first against any income derived by the trustee in that income year which is assessable to the trustee as income not derived by a beneficiary entitled in possession to the receipt of it under the trust during that year, and then, as to any balance, against any income derived in that year by or in trust for a beneficiary who has a vested interest in the capital of the estate to the extent that the loss is chargeable against the capital of that beneficiary; and any balance not allowed as a deduction in that year shall, so far as it extends, be allowable as a deduction in the same manner successively during the six succeeding years.

Income Tax Act 1961

PART 6
AGENTS AND NON-RESIDENTS

Introduction

939

89 “Absentee” defined

In this Part “absentee” means –
(a) Any person (other than a company) who is for the time being out
of Niue;
(b) Any overseas company unless it has a fixed and permanent place
of business in Niue at which it carries on business in its own name;
(c) Any overseas company which is declared by the Treasurer to be an
absentee for the purposes of this Act by notice given to that company
or to its agent or attorney in Niue, so long as that declaration remains
unrevoked.

90 Rate and amount of tax payable by agent

Except where otherwise expressly provided by this Act, the rate of tax for
which an agent shall be so assessed and liable shall be determined by reference to
the total taxable income of the principal, but it shall be charged and payable only
on the income in respect of which the agency exists, and in the same proportion
which that income bears to the total taxable income of the principal.

91 Liability of principal not affected

(1) Nothing in this Act relating to an agent shall be so construed as to release
the principal from liability to make returns and to be assessed and chargeable
with tax.
(2) No assessment of the agent shall preclude an assessment of the principal
for the same tax, nor shall an assessment of the principal preclude an assessment
of the agent for the same tax, and the principal and agent shall be jointly and
severally liable for all tax for which the agent is liable.
(3) When 2 or more persons are liable to be assessed as agents in respect of
the same tax, they shall be jointly and severally liable for it.

92 Agents may recover tax from principal

When an agent pays any tax he may recover the amount so paid from his
principal, or may deduct the amount from any moneys in his hands belonging or
payable to his principal.

93 Agent may retain from moneys of principal amount required for tax

An agent may during the year preceding the year of assessment, or at any
later time, retain out of any moneys belonging or payable to his principal such
sums as may reasonably be deemed sufficient to pay the tax for which the agent is
or may become liable.

94 Assessment deemed authority for payment of tax by agent

An assessment made by the Treasurer shall, as between an agent and his
principal, be a sufficient authority for the payment by the agent of the tax so
assessed and the agent shall be entitled as against his principal to reimbursement
accordingly.
940 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

95 Agents to be personally liable for payment of tax

(1) Every agent shall be personally liable for the tax on income in respect
of which he is an agent.
(2) When the Treasurer is satisfied that an agent has no moneys of his
principal with which he can pay the tax, and that he has not paid away any such
moneys after notice of assessment of the tax, or that immediate enforcement of
payment by the agent would be a cause of hardship, the Treasurer may allow the
agent such further period for the payment, not exceeding 6 months after the date
of the notice of assessment, as he thinks necessary and the additional tax imposed
by section 115 on taxpayers in default shall not accrue until the expiry of the periods
so allowed.

96 Agents to make returns and be assessed as principal

(1) Every agent shall make returns of the income in respect of which he is
an agent, and shall be assessed thereon in the same manner as if he was the
principal, save that he shall be entitled to no special exemption other than such
exemption (if any) as his principal may be entitled to.
(2) Every person liable to furnish a return as agent for any person shall
furnish a separate return for each person for whom he is agent, in addition to his
own individual return.

97 Relation of principal and agent arising in effect

When the Treasurer is satisfied that any person carrying on business in
Niue (herein called the agent) is so far under the control of any other person
carrying on business in Niue or elsewhere (herein called the principal) that the
relation between them is in effect that of agent and principal, he may treat the first
mentioned business as that of the principal, and as being carried on by the agent
on his behalf, and may require returns to be made, and may make assessments
accordingly, and the principal and agent shall be liable for income tax accordingly.

Special Cases of Agency

98 Liability of mortgagee in possession

For the purposes of this Act, a mortgagee in possession of any land or other
property shall be deemed to be the agent of the mortgagor in respect of any income
derived by that mortgagee from that land or other property on behalf of or for the
benefit of the mortgagor, and the mortgagee shall make returns and be assessable
and liable for tax on that income accordingly, and all the provisions of this Act as
to agents shall, as far as they are applicable, apply accordingly.

99 Guardian of person under disability to be his agent

Every person who, as guardian, committee, or otherwise has the receipt,
control or disposition of any income derived by a person under any legal disability
shall for the purposes of this Act be the agent of that person in respect of that
income, and shall make returns and be assessable and liable for income tax
accordingly.

100 Local and public authorities and companies deemed agent of debenture holders

(1) Save as otherwise provided in section 75 and section 101, every company and local and public authority which has issued debentures, whether charged on the property of the company where appropriate or not, shall for the purposes of this Act be the agent of all debenture-holders, whether absentees or not, in respect of all income derived by them from those debentures, and shall make returns and be assessable and liable for income tax on that income accordingly.

Income Tax Act 1961

941
(2) No deduction by way of special exemption or otherwise shall be allowed to the company or local or public authority as such agent, or to any debenture- holders, in respect of the income so derived from debentures.
(3) Income so derived by holders of debentures issued by a company or a local or public authority shall be assessable and chargeable with income tax in conjunction with income derived by the debenture-holders from other sources, if any, and at the rate appropriate to the total income so derived.
(4) Nothing in this section shall be so construed as to render liable to income tax any income that is exempt from taxation by virtue of section 49.

101 Modification in respect of income from company debentures, or local or public authority debentures

(1) The duty to act as the agents of debenture holders imposed on companies or local or public authorities by section 100 shall not apply with respect to debentures issued to any person resident in Niue if the company or local or public authority that has issued such debentures has supplied to the Treasurer, before it has been assessed in any year for income tax in respect of the income derived from those debentures, a certified list specifying the numbers of the debentures or other particulars sufficient to identify them, the names, addresses, and descriptions of the persons to whom the debentures have been issued, the interest derived or derivable therefrom, and such other particulars as may be prescribed.
(2) Where any such list is supplied the person named in it as the holder of any debentures shall be personally responsible for the making of returns, and shall be assessable and liable for income tax (though not to the exclusion of any other person) in respect of the income derived from those debentures at the rate fixed in respect thereof, unless and until he satisfies the Treasurer, before he has been assessed for income tax in any year, that he has transferred or assigned the debentures, and has given notice to the Treasurer in the prescribed form of the name, address, and description of the transferee or assignee.
(3) Every person being the transferee or assignee of any debenture shall in like manner remain personally liable in respect of it (though not to the exclusion of any other person) unless and until he has given notice to the Treasurer in the prescribed form of the transfer or assignment of the same.
(4) Any tax paid by the former holder of any debentures in respect of the
income derived from it by a subsequent holder shall be deemed to be paid on
behalf of that subsequent holder so far as it does not exceed the tax to which the
subsequent holder might himself have been liable in respect of such debentures,
and may be recovered by the former holder from such subsequent holder
accordingly.

102 Recovery of income tax payable in respect of alimony or maintenance

(1) This section applies with respect to any income tax that may hereafter
become payable in respect of income received by or on behalf of any person as
alimony or maintenance, pursuant to the order of any Court or pursuant to any
deed or agreement.
(2) In any case to which this section applies, the person bound by any such
order, deed, or agreement to pay any moneys as alimony or as maintenance as
aforesaid, shall for the purpose of the payment of the income tax thereon, be
deemed to be the agent of the person to whom or on whose behalf such moneys
have been paid or are payable, and all the provisions of this Act as to the liability
of agents shall apply with respect to him accordingly.
942 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) It shall be no defence in any proceedings against an agent for the recovery of any income tax to which this section relates that any amount in respect of income tax has been paid by him to the person entitled to receive any moneys as alimony or maintenance.

Agents of Absentees and Non-residents

103 Liability of agent of absentee principal for returns and tax

Every person who in Niue carries on any business for and on behalf of a
principal who is an absentee shall for the purposes of this Act be the agent of that
principal in respect of all income derived by the principal through the business so
carried on in Niue by means of that agent, and the agent shall make returns and
be assessable and liable for income tax on that income accordingly, whether the
incomes to the hands of the agent or not.

104 Partner of absentee deemed agent

Every person who in Niue carries on business in partnership with an
absentee shall for the purposes of this Act be the agent of that absentee in respect
of his share of the income of the business, and shall make returns and be assessable
and liable for income tax accordingly.

105 Master of ship or captain of aircraft deemed agent of absentee owner

(1) When an absentee, by means of any ship or aircraft owned by him or
under charter to him, carries on the business of the carriage of merchandise, mails
or passengers the master of that ship, or the captain of that aircraft, as the case
may be, shall (though not to the exclusion of any other agent) be the agent of that
absentee for the purposes of this Act in respect of all assessable income so derived
by that absentee, and shall be assessable and liable for income tax accordingly.
(2) Pending the payment of any tax assessed against such an absentee or
against any person who is his agent for the purposes of this Act, the Financial
Secretary shall, on the requisition of the Treasurer, withhold the clearance of the
ship or aircraft in respect of which the tax is payable.

106 Tenant, mortgagor or other debtor, to be agent of absentee landlord, mortgagee or other creditor

(1) Any tenant, mortgagor or other person who transmits from Niue to any landlord, mortgagee or other creditor, being an absentee, any rent, interest, or other moneys being income derived by that absentee from Niue, shall for the purposes of this Act be the agent of that absentee in respect of all moneys so transmitted by him at any time, and he shall in respect of all such moneys make returns and be assessable and liable for income tax accordingly.
(2) For the purposes of this section any moneys paid by or on account of a
person resident in Niue from a fund situated out of Niue shall be deemed to be
moneys transmitted by that person from Niue.

107 Person having disposal of income deemed agent

Every person who in Niue has the receipt, control or disposal of any income
derived by a principal who is an absentee shall for the purposes of this Act be the
agent of the principal in respect of that income, and shall make returns and be
assessable and liable for income tax on that income accordingly.

Income Tax Act 1961

943

108 Company to be agent of absentee shareholders

A Niue company which is exempt from income tax shall be the agent of all
shareholders or members who are absentees, and the company shall make returns
and be assessable accordingly on all dividends and other profits paid or credited
by the company to such shareholders or members at any time while they are
absentees.

109 Banking company to be agent of absentee depositors

Every banking company, and every other company, local or public authority,
or other person, who in the course of business receives or holds money by way of
deposit and allows interest thereon shall for the purposes of this Act be the agent
of all depositors who are absentees, and shall make returns and be assessable and
liable for income tax accordingly on any interest which is paid or credited to a
depositor while he is an absentee if that interest exceeds $400 in any year.

110 Premiums on insurance effected with persons not carrying on business in Niue

(1) Where any person in Niue enters into a contract of insurance or guarantee against loss, damage, or risk of any kind whatever (not being a contract of life insurance) with any person or overseas company not carrying on business in Niue, such last mentioned person or such company shall be liable to income tax at the rate as set out in Schedule 1 as being applicable to insurance companies on the amount of premium paid or payable by the first mentioned person in respect of such contract.
(2) Where the amount of premium paid or payable in respect of any such contract is not disclosed, the amount shall be deemed to be the same amount as would be chargeable in respect of a similar contract of insurance or guarantee effected with a company carrying on business in Niue.
(3) Every person who enters into a contract of insurance or guarantee as
aforesaid shall for the purposes of this Act be deemed to be the agent of the person
or overseas company with whom such contract is made, and shall make returns
and be assessable and liable for income tax accordingly.
(4) Every person who exports any goods from Niue shall notify the
Treasurer if such goods are insured, and, if so, the name and description of the
person or company with whom such goods are insured, and the amount of the
premium payable in respect of it.

111 Liability as agent of employer of non-resident taxpayer and employer’s agent

(1) The employer or the agent of the employer of every non-resident taxpayer shall, for the purposes of this Act, be the agent of such non-resident taxpayer in respect of the salary, wages, or other emoluments received by him, and shall make returns and be assessable and liable for income tax thereon accordingly.
(2) Where any such non-resident taxpayer has made default in the payment of any income tax payable by him in respect of his salary, wages, or other emoluments as aforesaid, the amount of such tax shall, on application by the Treasurer, be deducted by the employer or his agent from any salary, wages, or other emoluments thereafter to be paid, and shall be paid to the Treasurer on behalf of the taxpayer.
(3) Where any non-resident taxpayer is in receipt of any pension or annuity payable out of any superannuation fund established in Niue, any income tax that
944 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
may hereafter become payable by such non-resident taxpayer in respect of such pension or annuity shall, on application by the Treasurer, be deducted from any instalment or instalments of such pension or annuity thereafter to be paid, and shall be paid to the Treasurer on behalf of the taxpayer.
(4) For the purposes of this section “non-resident taxpayer” means any person who, being liable for income tax in respect of salary, wages, or other employment derived from Niue, or in respect of any annuity or pension derived from Niue has no fixed and permanent residence or place of abode in Niue.

112 Non-resident trader to be agent of employees in Niue

(1) Every non-resident trader shall for the purposes of this Act be the agent
of all persons in his employment in Niue in respect of the salary, wages or other
emoluments received by them, and shall make returns and be assessable and liable
for income tax thereon accordingly.
(2) The agent in Niue of a non-resident trader shall, for the purposes of
this section, be under the same obligations as his principal.

113 Agents in Niue of principals resident or carrying on business abroad

When any person in Niue, on behalf of a principal resident or carrying on
business out of Niue, is instrumental in procuring the purchase from that principal
of goods or merchandise which are in Niue or are to be imported into Niue in
pursuance or in consequence of such purchase, whether the contract or purchase
is made in Niue or elsewhere, the principal shall in respect of the sale by him of
such goods or merchandise be deemed to be carrying on business in Niue through
the agency of that person; and the income derived from such business shall be
deemed to be derived from Niue, in the same manner and to the same extent as if
the contract had been made in Niue, and shall be assessable for income tax
accordingly and the agent shall make returns and pay tax accordingly.
PART 6A
TAX DEDUCTIONS BY EMPLOYERS

113A Application of this Part

(1) This Part shall apply notwithstanding anything in any other Part.
(2) This Part shall apply to salary or wages for any period on or after 1
April 1984 and to other source deduction payments which are paid or would
normally be paid on or after that date, notwithstanding that any such other source
deduction payment may as to the whole or any part thereof be for a period before
that date.
(3) If any question is raised as to whether or not a source deduction
payment is as to the whole or any part of it subject to this Part, it shall be determined
by the Treasurer whose decision shall be final.
(4) The amount of income tax for which an employee is liable in respect of
the income earned by him in any income year shall be assessed under Part 5.

113B Tax deductions to be made by employers

For the purpose of enabling the collection of income tax from employees
by instalments, where an employee receives a source deduction payment from an
employer, the employer or other person by whom the payment is made shall, at
the time of making the payment, make a tax deduction therefrom under this Part.

Income Tax Act 1961

945

113C Amount of tax deductions

(1) (a) The Treasurer shall issue tables based on the tax rates specified in
this Act detailing the tax deductions that shall be made from every
payment of salary and wages according to the amount of the
payment the length of the pay period and the tax code of the
employee; and every employer shall make tax deductions from
every payment of salary or wages accordingly.
(b) No tax deduction need be made from any source deduction payment
made to any employee in respect of his employment as a private
domestic worker.
(c) If a tax deduction is not made by the employer in any such case
section 113J shall apply to the employee.
(2) Where the source deduction payment is being made in respect of an
employee who has not made a declaration for the purposes of the tax code the
basic tax deduction shall be the appropriate amount that would be deducted if
the tax code of the employee were ‘S’.

113D Tax codes

For the purpose of this Part the tax code of any employee in relation to any
source deduction payment shall be such one of the following codes as applies to
the employee namely –
“no declaration”, signifying an employee who has not delivered to the
employer a tax code declaration;
“s”, signifying an employee who has no dependants;
“s+( )”, signifies an employee who has a dependant relative or dependant
relatives where the number in brackets signifies the number of
dependant relatives;
“SEC”, signifies an employee who undertakes secondary employment in
addition to primary employment.

113E Dependants

(1) This section shall apply for the purpose of determining the tax code
applicable to an employee.
(2) The spouse of the employee shall be deemed to be a dependant of the
employee for the purposes of the tax code based on a tax code declaration which
includes the spouse as a dependant if –
(a) The marriage has subsisted at any time during the year in which
the employee delivers the tax code declaration to the employer or
to the Treasurer, and the spouse has been supported by the employee
at any time during that year; and
(b) The spouse has not in the year in which the tax code declaration is
delivered derived income in excess of $624; and
(c) When the tax code declaration is delivered the employee anticipates
that the income as aforesaid already derived and to be derived by
the spouse in that year will not exceed in the aggregate $624.
(3) A spouse who under subsection (2) is a dependant of an employee for
the purposes of any tax code shall cease to be such a dependant if and when,
before the tax code ceases to apply to the employee, the employee knows or
anticipates, or should have known or anticipated, that the income as aforesaid
derived and to be derived by the spouse in the year aforesaid has exceeded or will
exceed $724.
946 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(4) A housekeeper shall be deemed to be a dependant of the employee for the purposes of the tax code based on a tax code declaration which includes the housekeeper as a dependant if, when the employee delivers the declaration to the employer or to the Treasurer, the employee anticipates that the aggregate amount of the payments to be made, during the year in which the tax code declaration is delivered, in respect of the services of a housekeeper or housekeepers will be not more than $300.
(5) A housekeeper who under subsection (4) is a dependant of an employee for the purposes of any tax code shall cease to be a dependant if and when, before the tax code ceases to apply to the employee, the employee knows or anticipates or should have anticipated that the aggregate amount of the payments as aforesaid to be made during the year aforesaid will be more than $300.
(6) A dependant relative as defined by section 45 shall be deemed to be a dependant of the employee for the purposes of the tax code based on a tax code declaration which includes the dependant relative as a dependant if, when the employee delivers the declaration to the employer or to the Treasurer, the employee anticipates that the dependant relative will qualify within the terms of section 45 as a dependant relative.
(7) A dependant relative who under subsection (6) is a dependant of an employee for the purposes of any tax code shall cease to be a dependant if and when before the tax code ceases to apply to the employee, the employee knows or anticipates or should have anticipated that the dependant relative does not qualify as a dependant relative within the terms of section 45.
(8) Except as provided in this section, no person shall be deemed to be a
dependant of an employee.

113F Tax code declaration

(1) Every employee shall at the commencement of his employment
complete a tax code declaration on the form prescribed by the Treasurer and deliver
the completed tax code declaration to his employer. The tax code as determined
by the particulars on that declaration shall be applied by the employer to that
employee for the purposes of this Part.
(2) Where the circumstances of the employee change such that the
employee ceases to be entitled to use the tax code based on his tax code declaration
or the employee is entitled to use another tax code he shall within 7 days of such
change in circumstances deliver to his employer another tax code declaration in a
form authorised by the Treasurer. The tax code as determined by the particulars
on the new declaration shall apply thereafter to the employee unless the tax
declaration is again changed by the employee under this section.
(3) Notwithstanding subsections (1) and (2) the Treasurer may in such
circumstances and to the extent that he thinks fit reduce or increase the amount of
any tax deduction required to be made from the source deduction payment of any
employee or class or classes of employees and the employer or the employers of
such an employee or employees shall make deductions accordingly.

113G Tax deductions to be credited to individual

(1) Every employee who is required to furnish or who furnishes to the
Treasurer a return of any assessable income derived by him in any income year
shall except where the Treasurer otherwise directs, forward to the Treasurer with
the return all tax deduction certificates delivered to the employee in respect of tax
deductions made in the income year from source deduction payments made to
the employee.

Income Tax Act 1961

947
(2) The Treasurer shall apply the total amount of the tax deductions shown on the certificates forwarded under subsection (1) in payment successively of –
(a) The income tax (if any) payable by the employee in respect of his income for the income year;
(b) The income tax (if any) due by the employee and unpaid in respect of previous income years;
and shall refund to the employee an amount equal to the amount of the tax deductions not so credited.
(3) If the Treasurer has reason to believe that any tax deduction certificate
received by him under this section is incorrect no action under subsection (2) shall
be taken by the Treasurer until he is satisfied that the certificate is correct.
(4) The employer and the employee shall be liable jointly for any error in
the amount shown in the tax deduction certificate which results in the crediting
of, or refund of income tax in excess of the amount that the employer had actually
deducted from a source deduction payment to which the certificate relates, and
the amount of the excess shall be payable by 31 January in the succeeding income
year.

113H Contribution to superannuation funds

(1) Where an employee is a contributor to a superannuation fund, the
amount of the salary or wages paid to the employee for a pay period shall, for the
purpose of calculating the amount of the tax deduction be deemed to be the residue
of the payment of salary and wages after subtracting therefrom the amount of the
regular current contributions made by the employee to the superannuation fund
for that period.
(2) The maximum amount subtracted as provided for in this section shall
not exceed $30.76 in any fortnightly pay period with a corresponding limitation
for other periods.

113I Tax deduction from amounts credited to or applied for employees

Where a source deduction payment, though not actually paid, is credited
to or applied on account of any employee entitled to it, the amount so credited or
applied shall, for the purposes of this Part be deemed to be paid when it is so
credited or applied and a tax deduction in respect of it shall be made accordingly.

113J Employee to pay deductions to Treasurer

Where for any reason a tax deduction is not made or is not made in full at
the time of the making of any source deduction payment or payments, the
employee shall –
(a) Not later than the 20th day of the month next after the month in
which payment of the source deduction payment or payments were
made, furnish to the Treasurer a return in the prescribed form of
the source deduction payment or payments; and
(b) Unless the employee is exempted from liability to pay the same or
is not liable to pay the same, pay to the Treasurer an amount equal
to the total of the tax deductions that should have been made and
were not made, and that amount shall be due and payable to the
Treasurer on the 20th day of the month next after the month in which
payment of the source deduction payment or payments was made.
948 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

113K Records to be kept by employer

(1) Every employer who makes a source deduction payment to any
employee shall keep a proper record in respect of the employee showing the
amount of the source deduction payment before making any tax deduction, and
the amount of the source deduction (if any) made from it, and shall enter these
amounts in the record at the time of making the source deduction payment.
(2) Every employer shall take all reasonable precautions for the safe custody
of all records that he is required to keep under this section, and of all pay sheets,
receipts for source deduction payments, tax deduction certificates, tax code
declarations, and tax code certificates, and shall retain all such records, pay sheets,
receipts, tax code declarations, and tax code certificates for not less than 7 years
after the making of the payments to which they relate except and to the extent
that he is required by this Act to deliver to the Treasurer the signed tax deduction
certificates tax code declarations, and tax code certificates.
(3) This section shall not require retention of any records, pay sheets,
receipts, tax code declarations, or tax code certificates in respect of which the
Treasurer has notified the employer that retention is not required.

113L Payment of tax deductions to Treasurer

Every employer who makes tax deductions from source deduction
payments made to employees shall –
(a) Not later than the 20th day of the month next after the month in
which he has made any such deductions, pay to the Treasurer the
amount of the tax deductions and deliver to the Treasurer a monthly
remittance certificate in a form authorised by the Treasurer and
showing the total amount of all source deduction payments made
by the employer to employees in the month before making any tax
deductions, and the total amount of all tax deductions made from
those payments;
(b) Not later than 31 May in each year, deliver to each employee a tax
deduction certificate signed by the employer, being a certificate in
a form authorised by the Treasurer and showing the total amount
of all source deduction payments made by the employer to the
employee in the preceding year (not including payments included
in a tax deduction certificate previously delivered to the employee),
and the total amount of the tax deductions made from this payments
together with such other information as the Treasurer may from
time to time prescribe;
(c) Not later than 31 May in each year deliver to the Treasurer a
reconciliation statement signed by the employer, being a certificate
in a form authorised by the Treasurer and showing the total amount
of all tax deductions paid to the Treasurer by the employer in respect
of source deduction payments made in the preceding year, and the
total amount of all tax deductions shown in tax deduction certificates
delivered to employees in respect of those source deduction
payments, together with an explanation if the two totals do not
agree, and, accompanied by signed copies of all those tax deduction
certificates delivered to him in the preceding year, and by all notices
cancelling relevant deductions given to him in that year under
section 113F.

Income Tax Act 1961

949

113M Tax deductions protected from creditors

The amount of every tax deduction made under this Part shall be held in
trust for the Crown; and any amount so held in trust shall not be the property of
the employer, and, in the event of the bankruptcy or liquidation of the employer
or of an assignment for the benefit of the employer ’s creditors, shall remain apart,
and form no part of the estate in bankruptcy, liquidation or assignment.

113N Employers who fail to make tax deductions

(1) Where an employer fails to make any tax deduction in accordance with
his obligations under this Part, the amount in respect of which default has been
made shall constitute a debt payable by the employer to the Treasurer on the 20th
day of the month next after the month in which payment of the source deduction
payment should have been made.
(2) The right of the Treasurer to recover from the employer the amount in
respect of which default has been made shall be in addition to any right of the
Treasurer to recover that amount from the employee under this Part and nothing
in this Part shall be construed as preventing the Treasurer from taking such steps
as he thinks fit to recover that amount from the employer and from the employee
concurrently, or from recovering that amount wholly from the employer or from
the employee or partly from the employer and partly from the employee.
(3) Where any amount, including a penalty, recoverable under this Part
from the employee is in fact paid by the employer, the amount so paid may be
recovered by the employer from the employee.

113O Additional tax for default in making tax

(1) Where –
(a) Any employer or other person by whom any source deduction
payment is made fails wholly or in part to make tax deduction
therefrom his obligations under this Part; or
(b) Any person who has made a tax deduction fails wholly or in part
within the prescribed time and in the prescribed manner to pay the
amount of the tax deduction to the Treasurer; or
(c) Any person who is liable to pay any amount to the Treasurer under
this Part fails to pay the amount on the due date for payment of it –
that employer or other person shall, unless the Treasurer is satisfied that he has
not been guilty or wilful neglect or default, be liable, without conviction, in addition
to any other penalty to which he may be liable, to a penalty equal to 10 percent of
the amount in respect of which default has been made.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1) (b) a tax deduction shall be deemed
to have been made if and when payment is made of the net amount of any source
deduction payment.
(3) A penalty imposed under this section shall for all purposes be deemed
to be of the same nature as the amount or part of it in respect of which it is imposed,
and shall be recoverable accordingly.
(4) Subject to this Part, the other Parts shall apply with respect to the amount
of every penalty imposed under this section as if it were additional tax under
section 116 and as if the person liable to the penalty were the taxpayer.
950 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

113P Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence against this Act who –
(a) Being an employer or other person by whom a source deduction
payment is made to an employee, fails wholly or in part to make a
tax deduction therefrom under his obligations under this Part; or
(b) Knowingly applies or permits to be applied the amount of any tax
deduction or any part of it for any purpose other than the payment
of the tax deduction to the Treasurer;
(c) Makes a false or misleading tax code declaration, or gives any false
information, or misleads or attempts to mislead the Treasurer or
any other officer, or any employer or other person, in relation to
any matter or thing affecting a tax deduction or a reduced deduction;
or
(d) Delivers or maintains or attempts to deliver or maintain, in
contravention of this Part, a tax code declaration or a tax code
certificate in respect of more than one employment, or otherwise
obtains or attempts to obtain, in contravention of this Part, the
benefit of a reduced deduction in respect of more than one
employment; or
(e) Alters any tax code certificate or special tax code certificate issued
by the Treasurer, or falsely pretends to be the employee named in
any such certificate, or has in his possession, without lawful
justification or excuse, a colourable imitation of any such certificate
or, in contravention of this Act, causes or attempts to cause any
employer or other person to refrain from making a tax deduction,
or to make a reduced deduction, by the production of any document
other than a tax code certificate or a special tax code certificate issued
to him by the Treasurer and for the time being in force; or
(f) Alters any tax deduction certificate, or falsely pretends to be the
employee named in any such certificate, or, in contravention of this
Act, obtains or attempts to obtain for his own advantage or benefit
credit with respect to, or a payment of, the whole or any part of the
amount of a tax deduction made from a source deduction payment
received by another person.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this section shall be liable
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 12 months or to a fine not exceeding 5
penalty units or to both.
(3) For the purposes of this section a tax deduction shall be deemed to
have been made if and when payment is made of the net amount of any source
deduction payment, and the amount of the tax deduction shall be deemed to have
been applied for a purpose other than the payment thereof if the amount of the
tax deduction is not duly paid to the Treasurer.
(4) No person shall be convicted of an offence under this section if he
satisfies the Court that the failure to comply with the requirements of the section
was due to illness, accident or other cause beyond his control.

113Q Application of other provisions to this Part

Subject to this Part, the other Parts shall apply with respect to every amount
that any employer, employee or other person is liable to account for or pay to the
Treasurer under this Part as if the amount were income tax.

Income Tax Act 1961

951

113R Withholding payments

Every taxpayer who receives payment for services rendered as a self
employed contractor to the Government shall have 10 percent of the total account
to be paid to the contractor withheld and paid to the Treasurer as a withholding
payment contributed towards the total tax payable by the contractor in respect of
his income in that income year.
PART 7
PAYMENT AND RECOVERY OF TAX

114 Due date for payment of tax

(1) Income tax shall, except where expressly made payable in any other
manner by this Act, be due and payable immediately a notice of assessment
purporting to be signed by the Treasurer has been given to the taxpayer or on
such later date as may be fixed by the Treasurer in the said notice.
(2) In any case where a notice of assessment in respect of any year has not
been issued, and the delay is, in the opinion of the Treasurer, due to any neglect,
default or omission of the taxpayer, then the Treasurer when issuing such notice
of assessment, may fix a date which may be before the date of issue of such
assessment, which shall be considered to be the date on which the tax payable
under that assessment became due and payable.

115 Payment of tax

Payment of taxes and other moneys payable under this Act shall be effected
at the Treasury.

115A Payments of tax

(1) There shall be payable by taxpayers who are in receipt of a sufficient
level of remuneration by way of salary or wages to render them liable for income
tax, such sum as the Treasurer by notice in writing in form numbered 1 set out in
Schedule 3 may direct, a regular sum by way of deduction from salary or wage, at
such time or at such intervals as the notice specifies, not exceeding twenty per
cent of the gross salary or wage, for the purpose of providing for payment of tax
assessed in each tax year.
(2) The Treasurer may by notice in writing, in the form numbered 2 in
Schedule 3 require any person to deduct from any amount payable to a taxpayer
by way of salary or wage such sum as may be specified in the notice, and to pay
every sum so deducted to the Treasurer for the credit of the taxpayer at such time
or at such intervals as may be specified in the notice.
(3) This section shall bind the Crown.
(4) (a) Such sums as are paid to Treasury by employers under subsections
(1) to (4) shall be credited to an account in the name of each
individual taxpayer, and shall be used only for the purpose of
meeting the whole or part of the tax assessed in any year in respect
of that taxpayer.
(b) The individual record of a taxpayer will be available for perusal by
that taxpayer on request in person during normal working hours,
but may not be removed from Treasury.
(5) (a) The sums so deducted shall be deemed to be deposits within the
meaning of section 12(a) Public Revenues Act 1959, but may not be
withdrawn until the tax for the year has been assessed and become
due and payable in terms of section 114 of this Act and will not
earn interest.
952 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) In the event of the amount to the credit of a taxpayer ’s account exceeding the amount of tax assessed and payable in terms of section
114 of this Act, a refund may be due to the taxpayer provided a surplus remains after taking into account deposits which have been lodged since 1 April in any tax year, as these deposits would be in respect of a new tax year and therefore not refundable.
(c) If a balance remains to the credit of a taxpayer ’s account after a final tax assessment has been paid prior to the taxpayer leaving the country, then such balance would be immediately refundable.
(6) Every person commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units who –
(a) Fails to make any deduction required by a notice under this section
to be made from any amount payable by him to a taxpayer;
(b) Fails after making any such deduction to pay the sum deducted to
the Treasurer within the time specified in that behalf in the notice.

116 If default, additional tax to be charged

(1) Subject to this section, if any tax remains unpaid at the expiration of
one month after the due date of it (whether already assessed or not), or after the
date of demand, as the case may be, five per cent on the amount of the tax unpaid
shall be and be deemed to be added to it by way of additional tax, and shall be
payable accordingly.
(2) In any case in which an assessment is increased after the due date of
tax, and the Treasurer is satisfied that the taxpayer has not been guilty of wilful
neglect or default in making due and complete returns for the purposes of that tax
the Treasurer shall in his notice to the taxpayer of the assessment or amended
assessment, or in any subsequent notice, fix a new date for the payment of the tax,
or of the increase, as the case may be, and the date so fixed shall be deemed to be
the due date of that tax or increase for the purposes of subsection (1).
(3) Where the taxpayer is resident beyond Niue and has no agent in Niue
the Treasurer shall, before charging the additional tax as aforesaid, grant such
further time, not exceeding 6 months after the due date of the tax, as he may deem
necessary.
(4) An application for relief made in writing by or on behalf of any taxpayer
who has become liable for the payment of any additional tax under subsections
(1)-(3), the Treasurer, if having regard to the circumstances of the case thinks it
equitable so to do, may, subject to this section, grant relief to the taxpayer –
(a) By the remission of the whole or part of such additional tax; or
(b) Where such additional tax has been paid in whole or in part, by the
refund to the taxpayer of the whole or any part of such tax that has
been paid, with or without the remission of any part of such
additional tax that has not been paid.
(5) No amount of tax in excess of $200 shall be remitted or refunded in any
year under this section except with the approval of Cabinet.

117 Mode of recovery of unpaid tax

All unpaid tax shall be recoverable by the Treasurer on behalf of the
Government by suit in the name of the Treasurer as a debt in the High Court.

Income Tax Act 1961

953

118 Deduction of income tax from payment due to defaulters

(1) Where any taxpayer has made default in the payment of any income
tax payable by him for any year of assessment, the Treasurer may by notice in
writing require any person to deduct from any amount payable or to become
payable by that person to the taxpayer such sum as may be specified in the notice,
and to pay every sum so deducted to the Treasurer to the credit of the taxpayer
within such time as may be specified in the notice.
(2) This section shall bind the Crown.
(3) Where any notice under this section relates to any wages or salary, the
sums required to be deducted therefrom shall be computed so as not to exceed a
deduction at the rate of one-twentieth per week of the tax due and payable by the
taxpayer at the date of the notice, or at the rate of 20 per cent of the wages or
salary, whichever rate is the less.
(4) Any notice under this section may be at any time revoked by the
Treasurer by a subsequent notice to the person to whom the original notice was
given (herein referred to as the debtor), and shall be so revoked at the request of
the taxpayer at any time when the Treasurer is satisfied that all income tax then
due and payable by the taxpayer has been paid, and that the Treasurer holds to
the credit of the taxpayer an amount not less than the amount of the income tax (if
any) to become due and payable by him during the then current year of assessment.
(5) A copy of every notice given under this section in respect of any taxpayer
and of the revocation of any such notice shall be given to the taxpayer by the
Treasurer.
(6) Whenever pursuant to a notice under this section any deduction is made
from any amount payable to any taxpayer the taxpayer shall be entitled to receive
from the debtor a statement in writing of the fact of the deduction and of the
purpose for which it was made.
(7) The sum deducted from any amount under a notice under this section
shall be deemed to be held in trust for the Crown, and, without prejudice to any
other remedies against the debtor or any other person, shall be recoverable in the
same manner in all respects as if it were income tax payable by the debtor.
(8) Every person commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 2 penalty units who –
(a) Fails to make any deduction required by a notice under this section
to be made from any amount payable by him to a taxpayer;
(b) Fails after making any such deduction to pay the sum deducted to
the Treasurer within the time specified in that behalf in the notice.

119 Procedure where defendant absent

In any action in the Court for the recovery of tax, if the defendant is absent
from Niue or cannot after reasonable inquiry be found, service of the summons
may with the leave of a Judge be affected by posting a duplicate or sealed copy
thereof in a letter addressed to the defendant at his present or last known place of
abode or business, whether in Niue or elsewhere.

120 Particulars of claim or demand

In an action in any court for the recovery of tax it shall be sufficient if the
particulars of claim or demand state the amount sought to be recovered and the
date on which same became payable, and such further particulars (if any) as the
Treasurer thinks necessary in order fully to inform the defendant of the nature of
the claim.
954 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

121 Collector may appear in legal proceedings by officer of the public service

In all proceedings in the Court on objection to an assessment of tax, and in
any action in the Court for the recovery of tax, the Treasurer and Collector of
Inland Revenue may, if either thinks fit, appear by some officer in the public service,
and the authority in writing of the Treasurer or the Collector stating that any person
so appearing is such an officer and that he appears for them shall be sufficient
evidence of the facts so stated and on his authority in that behalf.

122 Costs against Treasurer

In all proceedings in any court for the recovery of tax, costs may be awarded
to or against the Treasurer in the same manner as in other cases.

123 Proceedings not affected by vacancy or change in office of Treasurer

No action instituted by the Treasurer for the recovery of tax, and no
proceedings on objection to an assessment of tax, shall abate by reason of any
vacancy in the office of the Treasurer, or shall be deemed defectively constituted
by reason of any change in the holder of that office, and every such action or
proceeding shall be continued in the ordinary course as if the Treasurer and his
successors in office were a corporation sole.

124 Crown Proceedings Act not affected

Nothing in this Act shall be so construed as to limit or affect the operation
of the Crown Proceedings Act 1950 and all rights and remedies conferred upon
the Crown in respect of the Government by that Act and by this Act shall co-exist,
and may be exercised independently of one another, and tax may be recovered
accordingly.

125 Recovery of tax paid by one person on behalf of another

Every person who under this Act pays any tax for or on behalf of any other
person shall be entitled to recover the same from that other person as a debt, or to
retain or deduct the same out of or from any money which is or becomes payable
by him to that other person; and if he has paid the same as mortgagee, then, until
repaid, it shall be deemed to form part of the moneys secured by the mortgagee
and shall bear interest at the same rate accordingly.

126 Payment of income tax by persons leaving Niue

(1) Upon the application of any person about to leave Niue, if the Treasurer
is satisfied –
(a) That the person is not liable to pay any income tax; or
(b) That all income tax payable by that person has been paid; or
(c) That satisfactory arrangements have been or will be made for the
payment of all income tax that is or may become payable by that
person –
the Treasurer shall issue a certificate to the effect that that person is not under any
liability for income tax requiring to be discharged before he leaves Niue.
(2) Every certificate under this section shall remain in force for such period
or until such date as may be specified in that behalf in the certificate.
(3) No ticket or other authority to travel from Niue by any ship or aircraft
shall be issued to or in respect of any person by the owner or charterer, or by any
representative or employee of the owner or charterer, of the ship or aircraft nor
shall any person be permitted to sign on or be engaged as a member of the crew of
any ship or aircraft leaving Niue unless and until a certificate issued under this
section in respect of that person and not expiring before the date of the departure

Income Tax Act 1961

955
of the ship or aircraft from Niue is presented to the owner or charterer, or to his representative or employee.
(4) On the first working day after the departure of any ship or aircraft from any port or place at which it takes on board passengers or crew for any destination beyond Niue, the owner or charterer of the ship or aircraft or the representative or employee of the owner or charterer at that port or place shall deliver or forward by post to the Treasurer all certificates so presented by persons travelling by the ship or aircraft, together with a list showing the names and last known address in Niue of every person who so travelled (not including, unless the Treasurer in any case otherwise requires, any member of the crew of or staff of the ship or aircraft not signing on or being engaged as a member of the crew at that port or place).
(5) If any person travels from Niue by any ship or aircraft under a ticket or other authority issued at any port or place or signs on or is engaged as a member of the crew in contravention of this section, the owner or charterer and the representative or employee (if any) of the owner or charterer at that port or place shall be personally liable jointly and severally to pay the amount of income tax (if any) that is or may become due and payable by that person in respect of income derived in the income year in which he leaves Niue or in any earlier year.
(6) Every person who acts in contravention of or fails to comply with this section or who makes a false declaration or furnishes false information for the purpose of obtaining a certificate or who having obtained a certificate transfers it to any other person, commits an offence against this Act.
PART 8
PENALTIES

127 Penalty for failure to furnish returns

(1) Every person who –
(a) Refuses or fails to furnish any return or information as and when
required by this Act or by the Treasurer; or
(b) Wilfully or negligently makes any false return, or gives any false
information, or misleads or attempts to mislead the Treasurer, in
relation to any matter or thing affecting his own or any other
person’s liability to taxation; or
(c) Refuses or fails without lawful justification to duly attend and give
evidence when required by the Treasurer, or to truly and fully
answer any question put to him or to produce any book or paper
required of him; or
(d) Obstructs any officer acting in the discharge of his duties or in the
exercise of his powers under this Act; or
(e) Commits any other breach of this Act for which no other penalty is
expressly provided; or
(f) Aids, abets, or incites any other person to commit any offence
against this Act –
commits an offence against this Act and is liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty
units.
(2) In any proceedings against a person for refusing or failing to furnish any return or information as and when required by the Act, or by the Treasurer, a certificate in writing signed by the Treasurer certifying that the return or information so required has not been received from that person at the place where or by the person to whom the return or information should have been furnished, shall, in the absence or proof to the contrary, be sufficient evidence that the defendant has refused or failed to furnish the return or information.
956 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

128 Fines recoverable

All fines under this Act shall be recoverable by way of prosecution in the
Court and only upon the information of the Treasurer, or of some person authorised
in writing by the Treasurer in that behalf; and the signature of the Treasurer to any
warrant of authority under this section shall be judicially noted.

129 Information may be laid within ten years

Notwithstanding anything in any other Act to the contrary any information
in respect of any time within 10 years after the termination of the year in which
the offence was committed.

130 Penal tax in case of evasion

If any taxpayer evades, or attempts to evade, or does any act with intent to
evade, or makes default in the performance of any duty imposed upon him by
this Act with intent to evade, the assessment or payment of any sum which is or
may become chargeable against him by way of tax (which sum is hereinafter
referred to as the deficient tax) he shall be chargeable, by way of penalty for that
offence, with additional tax (penal tax) not exceeding an amount equal to the
amount of the deficient tax.

131 Nature of penal tax

Subject to this Part penal tax shall for all purposes be deemed to be tax of
the same nature as the deficient tax, and shall be deemed to be payable in and for
the same year of assessment as the deficient tax.

132 Assessment of penal tax

The penal tax shall be assessed by the Treasurer in the same manner, so far
as may be, as the deficient tax, but separately from it.

133 Objections to penal tax

(1) Any such assessment of penal tax shall be subject in the same manner
as any other assessment of tax, to objection on the ground that the person so
assessed is not chargeable with penal tax, or on the ground that the amount so
assessed is excessive.
(2) All the provisions of this Act as to objections shall apply to an objection
to an assessment of penal tax, save that the burden of proving the offence in respect
of which penal tax is chargeable shall lie upon the Treasurer.

134 Recovery of penal tax

An assessment of penal tax may be made and the tax so assessed shall be
recoverable at any time whether before or after the deficient tax has been assessed
or become assessable or payable, or has been paid.

135 Recovery of penal tax from executors or administrators

(1) Penal tax shall be assessable against and recoverable from the executors
or administrators of a deceased taxpayer, but, if so assessed, the amount of it shall
be recoverable only as a debt incurred by the deceased in his lifetime.
(2) No penal tax shall be recoverable from any person other than the
taxpayer himself, or his executors or administrators.

136 Amendment of assessment of penal tax

An assessment of penal tax may be amended in the same manner as any
other assessment.

Income Tax Act 1961

957

137 Limitation of time for assessment of penal tax

No assessment of penal tax shall be made or increased at any time after the
expiration of 10 years after the year of assessment of the deficient tax.

138 Recovery of penal tax not affected by conviction of taxpayer

The assessment of recovery of penal tax in respect of any offence shall not
be in any manner barred or affected by the fact that the taxpayer has been convicted
under this Act of the same or any other offence; but no person who has paid the
penal tax assessed against him for any offence shall be thereafter convicted of the
same offence.
PART 9
GENERAL

139 Treasurer to have power to inspect books and documents

(1) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any other Act, the Treasurer
or any officer of the Government authorised by him in that behalf shall at all times
have full and free access to all books and documents, whether in the custody or
under the control of a public officer or a body corporate or any other person
whatsoever, for the purpose of inspecting any books and documents which the
Treasurer or officer considers necessary or relevant for the purpose of collecting
any tax or duty which the Treasurer is authorised to collect, or considers likely to
provide any information otherwise required for any such purpose, and may,
without fee or reward, make extracts from or copies of any such books or
documents.
(2) The Treasurer or any officer of the Government authorised by him in
that behalf, may for the purposes of any investigation under this section require
the owner or manager of any property or business, to give him all reasonable
assistance in the investigation and to answer all proper questions relating to any
such investigation either orally, or, if the Treasurer or officer so requires, in writing,
or by statutory declaration, and for that purpose may require the owner or manager
or, in the case of a company, any officer of the company to attend at the premises
with him.

140 Information to be furnished on request of Treasurer

(1) Every person (including any officer employed in or in connection with
any department of the Government or by any public authority, and any other
public officer) shall, if required by the Treasurer or by any officer of the Government
authorised by him in that behalf furnish in writing any information and produce
any books and documents which the Treasurer or officer considers necessary or
relevant for any purpose relating to the administration or enforcement of this Act
or any other Act administered by the Treasurer, and which may be in the
knowledge, possession, or control of that person.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1) it is hereby declared that the information
in writing which may be required under this section shall include lists of
shareholders of companies, with the amount of capital contributed by and
dividends paid to each shareholder, copies of balance sheets and of profit and loss
accounts and other accounts and statements of assets and liabilities of any person.
(3) The Treasurer or any officer of the Government authorised by him in
that behalf may require that any written information or particulars furnished under
this section shall be verified by statutory declaration or otherwise.
958 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

141 Inquiry before a Judge or Commissioner of the High Court

(1) In any case in which the Treasurer deems it necessary to hold an inquiry
for the purpose of obtaining any information with respect to the liability of any
person for any tax or duty which the Treasurer is authorised to collect or any
other information required for the purposes of the administration or enforcement
of this Act or any other Act administered by the Treasurer, he may apply in writing
to a Judge or Commissioner of the High Court to hold an inquiry under this section.
(2) For the purposes of any such inquiry the Judge or Commissioner of the
High Court may summon before him and examine on oath touching any matter
which is relevant to the subject matter of the inquiry, all persons whom the
Treasurer or any other person interested requires to be so called and examined.
(3) The Judge or Commissioner of the High Court shall have all such
jurisdiction and authority touching the summoning and examination of any such
person as he would have in respect of a witness in a civil action within his ordinary
jurisdiction and the person so summoned and examined shall, subject to this Act,
have all such rights and be subject to all such liabilities as he would have and be
subject to if he were such a witness as aforesaid.
(4) (a) The Treasurer and every person who is interested in the subject
matter of the inquiry may be represented by a barrister or solicitor,
or, with the leave of the Court, by any other person, who may
examine, cross-examine and re-examine under the ordinary practice,
any person so summoned.
(b) Every person so summoned may be cross-examined by the Treasurer
or by the Treasurer ’s barrister or solicitor.
(5) Every examination under this section shall take place in chambers.
(6) The statement of every person so examined shall be taken down in
writing and signed by him in the presence of the Judge or Commissioner of the
High Court and delivered to the Treasurer and shall not form part of the records
of the Court.
(7) No person summoned or examined under this section shall be excused
from answering any question on the ground that the answer may incriminate him
or render him liable to any penalty or forfeiture.
(8) No statement made by any such person in answer to any question put
to him shall in criminal proceedings be admissable in evidence against him, except
upon a charge of perjury against him in respect of his testimony upon that
examination.
(9) A person summoned under this section may receive such sum on
account of travelling expenses and loss of time as the Judge or Commissioner of
the High Court thinks reasonable and orders accordingly.

142 Inquiry by Treasurer

(1) The Treasurer may, for the purpose of obtaining any information with
respect to the liability of any person for any tax or duty which the Treasurer is
authorised to collect or any other information required for the purposes of the
administration or enforcement of any Act administered by the Treasurer, by notice
in writing, require any person to attend and give evidence before him or before
any officer of the department authorised by him in that behalf and to produce all
books and documents in the custody or under the control of that person which
contain or which the Treasurer or the authorised officer considers likely to contain
any such information.
(2) The Treasurer may require any such evidence to be given on oath and
either orally or in writing.

Income Tax Act 1961

959
(3) If any person required to give evidence under this section refuses or wilfully neglects to appear before the Treasurer or authorised officer or to take an oath as witness or if any person being sworn as a witness at any such inquiry refuses or wilfully neglects to answer any question put to him touching the subject matter of the inquiry or to produce to the Treasurer or authorised officer any such documents as aforesaid, that person shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(4) If any person wilfully gives false evidence at any inquiry under this section he shall be guilty of perjury within the meaning of the Niue Act 1966.
(5) A person required to attend before the Treasurer or an authorised officer may receive such sum on account of travelling expenses and loss of time as the Treasurer thinks reasonable and orders accordingly.

143 Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence against sections 139 to 142 who –
(a) Acts in contravention of, or, without lawful justification or excuse,
fails to comply in any respect with any provision of those sections
or any requirement imposed thereunder;
(b) Wilfully deceives or attempts to deceive the Treasurer or any officer
of the department in the exercise of any powers or function under
those sections;
(c) With intent to deceive makes any false or misleading statement or
any material omission, in any information given to the Treasurer or
any officer of the department for the purposes of those sections.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against any one of sections 139
to 142 for which no other penalty is prescribed shall be liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

144 Keeping of business records

(1) Subject to subsection (2) every person carrying on business or deriving
income other than salary or wages shall keep sufficient records in the English or
Niuean language to enable his assessable income and allowable deductions to be
readily ascertained by the Treasurer or any officer authorised by him in that behalf
and shall retain all such records so kept.
(2) This section shall not require the retention of any records –
(a) In respect of which the Treasurer has notified the taxpayer in writing
that retention is not required;
(b ) Of a company which has been wound up and finally dissolved.
(3) For the purposes of this section “records” includes books of account
recording receipts or payments or income or expenditure or purchases or sales,
and also includes vouchers, invoices, receipts, and such other documents as are
necessary to verify the entries in any such books of account and in the case of an
agent, records of all transactions carried out on behalf of his principal.
(4) Every person who fails to comply with this section commits an offence.

145 Employers to make returns as to employees

Every person shall from time to time, as required by the Treasurer, make a
return of all persons employed by him during any year, and of all salaries, wages,
allowances and other emoluments received during that year by each person so
employed.
960 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

146 Return of interest paid on deposits

Every bank, local or public authority or other company or person who in
the course of business holds money by way of deposit and allows interest thereon
shall from time to time, as required by the Treasurer, make a return of all interest
so allowed during the year or other period to which the requisition of the Treasurer
relates, together with the names, addresses, and occupations of the person to whom
such interest has been allowed.

147 Returns as to debentures and interest thereon

Every company or local or public authority shall as required by the Treasurer
make a return giving such particulars as the Treasurer requires relative to
debentures issued by that company or local or public authority the holders thereof,
and the interest paid or payable on it.

148 Excess tax may be repaid within four years

(1) In any case where the Treasurer is satisfied that tax has been paid in
excess of the amount properly payable he shall advise the person concerned of
the excess payment and shall refund the amount paid in excess if written
application for the refund is made by or on behalf of the taxpayer –
(a) In any case where the assessment of the tax has not been altered,
within 4 years after the end of the year in which the assessment
was made;
(b) In any case where the original assessment has been altered (whether
once or more than once), within 4 years after the end of the year in
which the original assessment was made.
(2) In any case where an assessment has been altered so as to increase the
amount of tax payable and the Treasurer is satisfied that by reason of that alteration
tax has been paid in excess of the amount properly payable, he shall advise the
person concerned of the excess payment and shall refund the amount so paid in
excess by reason of that alteration if written application for the refund is made by
or on behalf of the taxpayer within 4 years after the end of the year in which the
alteration was made, notwithstanding that the application may be made after the
time allowed by subsection (1).

149 In cases of serious hardship Treasurer may grant relief to taxpayer

(1) In any case where it is shown to the satisfaction of the Treasurer –
(a) That any taxpayer has suffered such loss or is in such circumstances
that the exaction of the full amount of the tax has entailed or would
entail serious hardship; or
(b) That, owing to the death of any person who if he had not died would
have been liable to pay tax, the dependants of that person are in
such circumstances that the exaction of the full amount of the tax
has entailed or would entail serious hardship –
he may, subject to this section, release the taxpayer or the executor or administrator
of the deceased taxpayer (as the case may be) wholly or in part from his liability,
and may make such alterations in the assessment as are necessary for that purpose,
and may if the tax as previously assessed or any part of it has been already paid,
refund any tax paid in excess of the amount of the assessment as altered under
this section.
(2) No amount of tax in excess of under $200 shall be remitted or refunded
in any one year under this section except with the approval of Cabinet.

Income Tax Act 1961

961

150 Agreements purporting to alter incidence of taxation to be void

Every contract, agreement, or arrangement shall be absolutely void in so
far as directly or indirectly it has or purports to have the purpose or effect of in
any way altering the incidence of income tax, or relieving any person from his
liability to pay such tax.

151 Debentures issued free of income tax

(1) Nothing in section 150 shall be so construed as to render void any
contract, agreement, or arrangement made or entered into by any company to the
effect that the interest on any debentures issued by that company shall be free of
income tax; and all such contracts, agreements and arrangements are hereby
declared to be valid and effective in accordance with this section unless the
company is expressly or impliedly prohibited, by its memorandum or articles of
association from making or entering into any such contract, agreement or
arrangement.
(2) Where any debentures issued by a company purport to be issued free
of income tax the company shall be liable for the payment of the income tax payable
in respect of it, and the debenture-holders shall be entitled to receive the full amount
of interest payable under the debentures.

152 Extension of time

Notwithstanding this Act where any person within Niue is residing
temporarily or permanently on some island other than Niue, and by reason of a
lack of or a delay in air and sea communication between that island and Niue, is
unable to assert his rights or to fulfil his obligations under this Act within the
proper time, then the Treasurer shall have power to grant the said taxpayer such
further extension or extensions of time as the Treasurer may deem necessary.

153 Airlines liable for taxation

Provision is hereby made for the introduction of a tax at the discretion of
and at a rate to be determined by Cabinet, to be applied to the gross revenue
generated by all airlines on such sectors into and out of Niue as may be determined
by Cabinet.
––––––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULES

1 Interpretation

SCHEDULE 1

Rates of Income Tax

Part A

In this Schedule “taxable income” means income on which income tax is payable.

2 Companies

The rate of income tax payable in respect of taxable income derived by a company

in Niue shall be 30 cents for every dollar of taxable income.

3 Other taxpayers

962 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

On all income not included within clause 2 the rate of income tax for every dollar of taxable income shall be the effective rate of tax ascertained by calculating tax on that income in accordance with the rates of tax specified in Part B and multiplying the tax so calculated by the number of dollars included in that income.

PART B

On so much income as –

The rate of tax for every dollar

Shall be cents

Does not exceed $5,000

10

Exceeds $5,000 but does not exceed $15,000

30

Exceeds $15,000 but does not exceed $35,000

40

Exceeds $35,000

50

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 2

RATE OF DEPRECIATION

1 Buildings

Reinforced concrete throughout

1 per cent of cost price

Brick, stone or concrete walled

11/2 per cent of cost price

Wooden-framed

21/2 per cent of cost price

Steel framed

1 per cent of cost price

Other buildings which cannot be

Such rate as may be fixed by the

Classified under any of the

Treasurer in the particular case

Preceding headings

2 Assets other than Builders

Plant, machinery, vehicles, etc

20 per cent of the

Other than those listed hereunder

diminishing value

Containers (casks, crates,

)

Drums, cans, bottles and

)

Other containers)

)

Dies

)

Fences

)

Libraries in the case

)

of professional men, but

)

not salaried taxpayers

)

Loose tools

Loose tools

)

Cost of replacements

Moulds

)

each year

Machine tools

)

Patterns

)

Pipelines

)

Printing type

)

Sacks

)

Small articles requiring frequent

)

Renewal (crockery, cutlery, linen, etc.)

)

The Treasurer may specify that the replacement costs of any other items not particular mentioned above may be allowed as a deduction in any year.

––––––––––––––––––––

Income Tax Act 1961

SCHEDULE 3

Low income rebate

(Section 41A)

963

Amount of assessable income of

Taxpayer

Rebate

$10,000 or less

whichever is the lesser amount

An amount equal to the income tax that would otherwise be payable on the assessable income of the taxpayer or $1000 being

More than $10,000 but less than $20,000

$1000 less 10 cents for each dollar of assessable income of the taxpayer in excess of $10,000

––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 4

Section 115A

Form No. 1

FORM OF NOTICE BY TREASURER TO TAXPAYER OF COMPULSORY REGULAR

DEPOSITS TOWARDS INCOME TAX

To .................................................................................................................................................... of ..................................................................................................................................................... Dear Sir/Madam,

In terms of section 115a (1) of the Income Tax Act 1961 you are hereby notified that

commencing on......................day...............................month..........................year you will be

required to make deductions from your fortnightly/weekly pay a sum calculated at the

rate of % of your gross pay for the period, and this sum will be deposited by your employer

with the Treasury to the credit of your account.

NOTE: Monies deposited to your account in Treasury by your employer in accordance

with this notice may not be withdrawn until the income tax for the year or part of the

year has been assessed and become payable in terms of section 114 of the Income Tax Act

1961. No interest will be paid on your deposit. Should the amount standing to the credit

of your account be insufficient to meet the amount of tax assessed, you will be required to

make a lump sum payment of the balance owing. Should the credit in your account exceed

the amount of tax assessed, a refund may be due to you provided a surplus remains after

taking into account deposits which have been lodged since 1 April in any year, as these

deposits are in respect of a new tax year and would not be refundable.

Yours faithfully

Treasurer

964 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Section 115A Form No. 2

FORM OF A NOTICE BY TREASURER TO EMPLOYERS TO MAKE DEDUCTIONS ON A REGULAR BASIS FROM AN EMPLOYERS PAY FOR INCOME TAX PURPOSES AND TO PAY SUMS SO DEDUCTED TO TREASURY

To .................................................................................................................................................... of ..................................................................................................................................................... Dear Sir/Madam

You are hereby given notice under section 115A(2) of the Income Tax Act 1961 to deduct

from the fortnightly/weekly pay of Mr/Mrs/Miss.....................................of who is presently

employed by you, until further notice, a sum calculated at the rate.......................% of his/

her gross salary/wages and to pay this sum to the Treasurer, Alofi

within..............................days of each pay day.

Yours faithfully

NOTE: Under section 115A(6) of the Income Tax Act every person commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units who –

(a) Fails to make any deduction required by notice under this section to be made from any amount payable by him to a taxpayer.

(b) Fails after making any such deduction to pay the sum deducted to the

Treasurer within the time specified in that behalf in the notice.

965

INCORPORATED SOCIETIES ACT 1908

1908/212 (NZ) – 1 January 1909

1 Short title

2 [Repealed]

3 Interpretation

4 Incorporated societies

5 Pecuniary gain

6 Rules of incorporated societies

7 Application for incorporation

8 Registrar to register society if in order

9 Certificate of incorporation

10 Members to be a body corporate

11 Name of society

11A Change of name

12 Appeal from Registrar to High Court

13 No liability on members for obligation of

society

14 Members to have no right to property of

society

15 Contracts by society

16 Service of summons on society

17 Security for costs where society is plaintiff

18 Registered office

19 Restriction of operations of society

20 Society not to engage in operations

involving pecuniary gain

21 Alteration of rules

22 Register of members

23 Annual financial statement

To make provision for the incorporation of societies which are not established for the purpose of pecuniary gain

1 Short title

This is the Incorporated Societies Act 1908.

2 [Repealed by 2004/270]

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“prescribed” means prescribed by this Act or by regulations;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of Incorporated Societies;
“society” means a society incorporated under this Act.
966 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

4 Incorporated societies

(1) Any society consisting of not less than 15 persons associated for any
lawful purpose but not for pecuniary gain may, on application being made to the
Registrar under this Act, become incorporated as a society under this Act.
(2) No such application shall be made except with the consent of a majority
of the members of the society.

5 Pecuniary gain

Persons shall not be deemed to be associated for pecuniary gain merely by
reason of any of the following circumstances, namely –
(a) That the society itself makes a pecuniary gain, unless that gain or
some part of it is divided among or received by the members or
some of them;
(b) That the members of the society are entitled to divide between them
the property of the society on its dissolution;
(c) That the society is established for the protection or regulation of
some trade, business, industry, or calling in which the members
are engaged or interested, if the society itself does not engage or
take part in any such trade, business, industry, or calling, or any
part of branch thereof;
(d) That any member of the society derives pecuniary gain from the
society by way of salary as the servant or officer of the society;
(e) That any member of the society derives from the society any
pecuniary gain to which he would be equally entitled if he were
not a member of the society;
(f) That the members of the society compete with each other for
trophies or prizes other than money prizes.

6 Rules of incorporated societies

(1) The rules of a society shall state or provide for the following matters –
(a) The name of the society, with the addition of the word
“Incorporated” as the last word in that name;
(b) The objects for which the society is established;
(c) The modes in which persons become members of the society;
(d) The modes in which persons cease to be members of the society;
(e) The mode in which the rules of the society may be altered, added
to, or rescinded;
(f) The mode of summoning and holding general meetings of the
society, and of voting thereat;
(g) The appointment of officers of the society;
(h) The control and use of the common seal of the society;
(i) The control and investment of the funds of the society;
(j) The powers (if any) of the society to borrow money;
(k) The disposition of the property of the society in the event of the
winding up of the society;
(l) Such other matters as the Registrar may require to be provided for
in any particular instance.
(2) The rules of the society may contain any other provisions which are
not inconsistent with this Act or with law.
(3) The rules of the society and any amendment of those rules shall be
printed or typewritten.

Incorporated Societies Act 1908

967

7 Application for incorporation

Every application for the incorporation of a society shall be made to the
Registrar in manner following –
(a) Two copies of the rules of the society having written an application
for incorporation in the form in Schedule 1 or to the like effect shall
be signed by not less than 15 persons being members of the society,
and each subscriber to the application shall add to his signature his
description and address, and his signature shall be attested by a
witness who is not a subscriber. When any body corporate is a
subscriber its seal shall be affixed to the said application;
(b) The 2 copies of the said rules so signed shall be delivered to the
Registrar, together with the prescribed fee and together with a
statutory declaration made by an officer of the society or by a
solicitor to the effect that a majority of the members of the society
have consented to the application, and that the rules so signed or
sealed are the rules of the society.

8 Registrar to register society if in order

The Registrar, on being satisfied that the requirements of this Act have been
observed, shall thereupon do the following things –
(a) Enter the name of the said society in the register kept by him under
this Act, together with such other particulars with respect to the
society as he thinks fit;
(b) Issue under his seal a certificate that the society is incorporated
under this Act;
(c) Register the rules of the society by sealing with his seal the said
copies of it;
(d) Return one of those copies to the subscribers and retain the other
copy.

9 Certificate of incorporation

Every certificate of incorporation issued under the seal of the Registrar
shall be conclusive evidence that all statutory requirements in respect of registration
and of matters precedent and incidental to it have been complied with, and that
the society is authorised to be registered and has been duly registered and
incorporated under this Act.

10 Members to be a body corporate

Upon the issue of the certificate of incorporation the subscribers to the rules
of the society, together with all other persons who are then members of the society
or who afterwards become members of the society under the rules thereof, shall,
as from the date of incorporation mentioned in the certificate, be a body corporate
by the name contained in the said rules, having perpetual succession and a common
seal, and capable forthwith, subject to this Act and to the said rules, of exercising
all the functions of a body corporate and of holding land.

11 Name of society

No society shall be registered under a name which is identical with that of
any other society registered under this Act, or of a company carrying on business
in Niue (whether registered in Niue or not), or of any other body corporate
established or registered in Niue under any Act, or so nearly resembles that name
as to be calculated to deceive, except where that other society or company or body
968 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
corporate, as the case may be, signifies its consent in such manner as the Registrar requires, and the Registrar is satisfied that registration of the society by the proposed name will not be contrary to the public interest.

11A Change of name

(1) If, through inadvertence or otherwise, a society at its first registration,
or on its registration by a new name, is registered by a name which is in
contravention of section 11, or of any enactment other than this Act, relating to
restrictions on the use of any name, the society shall, within a period of 6 weeks
from the date of its being required by the Registrar to do so, or such longer period
as he may allow change its name under section 21 to a name that is not in
contravention as aforesaid.
(2) If a society makes default in complying subsection (1) it commits an
offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units
for every day on which the offence has continued.
(3) No fee shall be payable to the Registrar in respect of an alteration of the
rules of a society if the alteration only changes the society’s name under the
requirements of subsection (1).

12 Appeal from Registrar to High Court

An appeal shall lie to the High Court from any refusal of the Registrar to
register a society or any enactment of the rules of a society, and the decision of the
Court on any such appeal shall be final.

13 No liability on members for obligation of society

Except when otherwise expressly provided in this Act, membership of a
society shall not of itself impose on the members any liability in respect of any
contract, debt, or other obligation made or incurred by the society.

14 Members to have no right to property of society

Except when otherwise expressly provided by this Act or by the rules of a
society, membership of a society shall not be deemed to confer upon the members
any right, title, or interest, either legal or equitable, in the property of the society.

15 Contracts by society

(1) Any contract which, if made between private persons, must be by deed
shall, when made by a society, be in writing under the common seal of the society.
(2) Any contract which, if made between private persons, must be in
writing signed by the parties to be charged with it may, when made by a society ,
be in writing signed by any person acting on behalf of and under the express or
implied authority of the society.
(3) Any contract which, if made between private persons, might be made
without writing may, when made by a society, be made without writing by any
person acting on behalf of and under the express or implied authority of the society.

16 Service on society

Any summons, notice, order, or other document required to be served upon
a society may be served by leaving the same at the society’s registered office, or
by sending it through the post in a registered letter addressed to the society at that
office.

Incorporated Societies Act 1908

969

17 Security for costs where society is plaintiff

Where a society is the plaintiff in any action or other legal proceeding, and
there appears by any credible testimony to be reason to believe that if the defendant
is successful in his defence the assets of the society will be insufficient to pay his
costs, any Court or Judge having jurisdiction in the matter may require sufficient
security to be given for those costs, and may stay all proceedings until that security
is given.

18 Registered office

(1) Every society shall have a registered office to which all communications
may be addressed.
(2) Notice of the situation of that office, and of any change shall be given
to the Registrar and recorded by him.
(3) Until that notice is given, the society shall be deemed not to have
compiled with this section as to having a registered office.
(4) If any society carries on its operations without having a registered office,
every officer of the society and every member of the committee or other governing
body of the society shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for
every day during which those operations are carried on.

19 Restriction of operations of society

(1) If any society carries on or proposes to carry on any operation which is
beyond the scope of the objects of the society as defined in its rules, the Registrar
may give notice in writing to the society not to carry on that operation.
(2) If after the receipt of that notice the society fails or refuses to conform,
every officer of the society and every member of the committee or other governing
body of the society shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for
every day during which that failure or refusal continues, unless he proves that the
failure or refusal has taken place without his authority or consent.

20 Society not to engage in operations involving pecuniary gain

(1) No society shall do any act of such a nature that if the doing thereof
were one of the objects for which the society was established the members of the
society would be deemed to be associated for pecuniary gain within the meaning
of sections 4 and 5.
(2) Every society which does any such act shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units.
(3) Every member who aids, abets, procures, assists, or takes part in the
doing of any such act by a society shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty
units, and all such members shall be jointly and severally liable to any creditor of
the society for all debts and obligations incurred by the society in or in consequence
of the doing of that act.
(4) Every member who derives any pecuniary gain from any act done by
the society in breach of this section shall be deemed to have received the same to
the use of the society, and the same may be recovered by the society accordingly.

21 Alteration of rules

(1) A society may alter its rules in manner provided by the said rules, but
subject to this Act.
(2) Every such alteration shall be in writing, signed or sealed in duplicate
by at least 3 members of the society, and take documents so signed or sealed shall
be delivered to the Registrar, accompanied by a statutory declaration made by a
970 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
solicitor or at least one member to the effect that the said alteration has been made in accordance with the rules of the society.
(3) The Registrar, if satisfied that the alteration has been duly made, and that the rules as so altered conform in all respects to this Act, shall register the alteration in like manner as in the case of the original rules, and the said alteration shall take effect according to its tenor. Such registration shall be conclusive evidence that all conditions precedent to the making of the alteration, or to the registration, have been duly fulfilled.
(3A) Notwithstanding subsection (3) the Court, on an application made
to it by any member of the society, if it is satisfied that any such condition as
aforesaid has not been duly fulfilled, declare the alteration to be void in whole or
in part, and order that the registration be cancelled in whole or in part, and may
by the order give such directions and make such provisions as seem just in the
circumstances of the case. On the delivery to the Registrar of a sealed copy of the
Court’s order he shall forthwith amend the register accordingly.
(4) No alteration in the objects of a society shall be registered unless the
Registrar is satisfied either that the alteration is not of such a nature as to
prejudicially affect any existing creditor of the society, or that all creditors who
may be so affected consent to the alteration.
(5) In the case of any alteration of the name of a society the Registrar may
refuse to register the alteration until the making of it has been publicly advertised
in such manner as the Registrar thinks fit.

22 Register of members

(1) Every society shall keep a register of its members.
(2) The register shall contain the names, addresses, and occupations of those
members and the dates at which they became members.
(3) Every society shall when required by the Registrar so to do, send to
him a list of the names, addresses, and occupations of its members, accompanied
by a statutory declaration verifying that list and made by some officer of the society.

23 Annual financial statement

(1) Every society shall deliver annually to the Registrar, in such form and
at such time as he requires, a statement containing the following particulars –
(a) The income and expenditure of the society during the society’s last
financial year;
(b) The assets and liabilities of the society at the close of the said year;
(c) All mortgages, charges, and securities of any description affecting
any of the property of the society at the close of the said year.
(2) The said statement shall be accompanied by a certificate signed up by
some officer of the society to the effect that the statement has been submitted to
and approved by the members of the society at a general meeting.
(3) If any default is made by a society in the observance of this section,
every officer of the society shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units
for every day during which the default continues.

24 Voluntary winding up of society

(1) A society may be wound up voluntarily if the society, at a general
meeting of its members, passes a resolution requiring the society so to be wound
up, and the resolution is confirmed at a subsequent general meeting called together
for that purpose and held not earlier than 30 days after the date on which the
resolution so to be confirmed was passed.

Incorporated Societies Act 1908

971
(2) In subsection (1) “resolution” means a resolution carried by a majority of the valid votes cast by members voting at a general meeting in person or, if so allowed by the society’s rules, by proxy; and for the purposes of that subsection the resolution shall be taken to be confirmed at the subsequent general meeting if the confirmation is carried by such a majority.

25 Winding up of society by High Court

A society may be wound up by the High Court under the following
circumstances –
(a) If the society suspends its operations for the space of a whole year;
or
(b) If the members of the society are reduced in number to less than 15;
or
(c) If the society is unable to pay its debts; or
(d) If the society carries on any operation whereby any member makes
any pecuniary gain contrary to this Act; or
(e) If the Court or a Judge is of the opinion that it is just and equitable
that the society should be wound up.

26 Petition to Court for winding up

(1) Any application to the Court for the winding up of a society shall be by
petition presented either by the society, or by a member or by a creditor or by the
Registrar.
(2) All costs incurred by the Registrar in making application for the winding
up of a society shall, unless the Court or a Judge otherwise orders, be a first charge
on the assets of the society.

27 Division of surplus assets on winding up

(1) On the winding up of a society or on its dissolution by the Registrar, all
surplus assets after the payment of all costs, debts, and liabilities shall, subject to
any trust affecting the same, be disposed of in manner provided by the rules of
the society or if such assets cannot be disposed of under the rules, then as the
Registrar directs.
(2) If the said surplus assets are subject to any trust, they shall be disposed
of as the Court or a Judge directs in the case of a winding up by the Court, or as
the Registrar directs in the case of a voluntary winding up or in the case of a
dissolution by the Registrar, but an appeal shall lie from any such decision of the
Registrar to the Court at the suit of any person interested.
(3) The decision of the Registrar under this section shall be final, unless
notice of appeal is delivered to the Registrar within one month after the decision
has been given.

28 Dissolution by Registrar

(1) If at any time the Registrar is satisfied that a society is no longer carrying
on its operations or has been registered by reason of a mistake of fact or law he
may make under his seal a declaration that the society is dissolved as from the
date of the declaration, and shall thereupon publish the declaration in the Gazette,
and make in the register an entry of the dissolution of the society.
(2) On the making of that entry the society shall be dissolved as from the
date of the declaration.
(3) At any time after it the Registrar, on being satisfied that the declaration
was made in error and ought to be revoked, may revoke the same by a declaration
972 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
published in the Gazette, and shall thereupon make an entry of that revocation in the register and the society shall be revived from the date of the dissolution as if no such dissolution had taken place.

29 Corporate body may become member of society

Any corporate body, whether incorporated under this Act or in any other
manner, may be a member of a society incorporated under this Act, unless the
purposes for which the society is established are ultra vires of the said corporate
body.

30 Pecuniary gain received by member

When any corporate body is a member of a society incorporated under this
Act, any pecuniary gain received by any member of that corporate body shall be
deemed for the purposes of this Act to be pecuniary gain received by a member of
the society, and in respect of any such pecuniary gain every member of that
corporate body shall be deemed to be a member of the society.

31 Corporate body to be equivalent to 3 members

In estimating –
(a) The number of subscribers to the rules of a society for the purposes
of section 4 or section 7, or to the rules of a branch or group of
branches for the purposes of section 37; or
(b) The number of members of a society for the purposes of section 4
or section 25 or of a branch for the purposes of section 37 and 38 –
every corporate body that is a subscriber or member shall be taken as the equivalent
of 3 subscribers or 3 members as the case may require.

32 [Repealed by 2004/270]

33 Register of incorporated societies

(1) The Registrar shall keep a register in which there shall be recorded all
matters required by this Act or by any regulations to be recorded by the Registrar.
(2) The Registrar shall keep a seal for the authentication of any documents
required for the purposes of this Act.
(3) There shall be paid to the Registrar such fees as may be prescribed by
regulations in respect of such matters as may be so prescribed.

34 Inspection of documents

(1) Every person may, inspect the register or any documents lodged with
the Registrar.
(2) Any person may, on payment of the prescribed fee, require a copy of
the certificate of the incorporation of any society, or a copy of or extract from the
register or any document lodged with the Registrar, to be certified by the Registrar
under his seal.
(3) Any such copy or extract purporting to be under the seal of the Registrar
shall be received in evidence in all proceedings, civil or criminal.
(4) No process for compelling the production of any document kept by
the Registrar shall issue from any Court except with the leave of that Court, and
every such process if issued shall bear on it a statement that it is issued with the
leave of the Court.

35 [Repealed]

Incorporated Societies Act 1908

973

36 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as it thinks fit for the purposes of this
Act.

37 Incorporation of branches

(1) Any society registered under this Act may apply to the Registrar in
accordance with this Act for the incorporation of any local branch having not less
than 15 members, or for the incorporation of a group or of groups of such branches
of that society.
(2) No application for the incorporation of a local branch shall be made
except with the consent of a majority of the members proposed to be incorporated
as a local branch, and no application for the incorporation of a group of branches
shall be made except with the consent of a majority of the members of each of
those branches.
(3) Any group of local branches may be incorporated notwithstanding that
the whole or any number of such branches may be already incorporated.

38 Application for incorporation of branch

Every application for the incorporation of a branch or group of branches of
a society registered under this Act shall be made to the Registrar in manner
following –
(a) Two copies of the rules of the branch or group, having written
thereon an application for incorporation, shall be signed by not less
than 2 of the executive officers of the registered society, and also, in
the case of a local branch, by not less than 15 persons being members
of that branch, and, in the case of a group of branches, by not less
than 2 members of each of the branches proposed to be incorporated.
(b) Each subscriber to the application shall add to his signature his
description and address, and his signature shall be attested by a
witness who is not a subscriber;
(c) When any body corporate is a subscriber its seal shall be affixed to
the said application;
(d) Two copies of the rules so signed or sealed shall be delivered to the
Registrar, together with the prescribed fee, and with a statutory
declaration made by an officer of the registered society, or by a
solicitor, to the effect that a majority of the members of the branch
or branches have consented to the application, and that the rules so
signed or sealed are the rules of the branch or group.

39 Registration of rules of branch

The Registrar, on being satisfied that the requirements of sections 37 and
38 have been observed, and that the rules of the branch of group of branches are
not inconsistent with this Act or with the rules of the registered society, shall
thereupon do the following things –
(a) Enter the name of the branch or group of branches in a special
register to be kept by him for the purposes of this Act, together
with such other particulars with respect to the branch or branches
as he thinks fit;
(b) Issue under his seal a certificate that the branch or group of branches
is incorporated under this Act;
(c) Register the rules of the branch or group of branches by sealing
with his seal the said copies of it; and
(d) Return one of those copies to the secretary of the registered society
and retain the other copy.
974 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

40 Application of Act

All the provisions of this Act (including the powers conferred on societies
to hold land) shall, so far as applicable, and with the necessary modifications,
apply to branches of societies or to groups of such branches incorporated under
sections 37 and 38.

41 Members of branches not to be relieved of obligations as members of societies

The incorporation of a branch of a society under sections 37 and 38 shall not relieve the members of that branch from any liabilities or obligations incident to their membership of the registered society, whether under this Act, or the rules of the society, or otherwise howsoever.

42 Evidence of membership of branch

For the purposes of this Act membership of a branch of a society shall be
determined in accordance with the general rules of the society and the special
rules (if any) of the branch in that behalf, and not otherwise, and every member of
a local branch shall be deemed to be a member of the society and liable to all the
obligations of membership.

43 Assistant Registrars

(1) There may be appointed such Assistant Registrars of incorporated
societies as may be required.
(2) (a) Subject to the direction of the Registrar, or to regulations under the
principal Act prescribing the duties of Assistant Registrars, every
Assistant Registrar shall have and may exercise all the powers,
duties, and functions of the Registrar.
(b) The fact of any Assistant registrar exercising any power, duty, or
function as aforesaid shall be conclusive evidence of his authority
so to do.

44 Rules of society may provide for penalties

In addition to the matters specified in section 6, the rules of any society
may make provision for the imposition on any member of reasonable fines and
forfeitures, and for the consequences of non-payment of any subscription or fine.

45 Improper use of word “Incorporated”

If any society, not being a society incorporated under this Act, operates
under any name or title of which the word “Incorporated” or any name or title of
which the word “Incorporated” or any contraction or imitation of that word is the
last word, every member of the society shall be liable on summary conviction to a
fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day upon which that name or title
has been used.

46 Society may make regulations or bylaws

(1) In addition to the matters specified in section 6 the rules of any society
may make provision for the making, amendment, or recission of regulations or
bylaws, not inconsistent with this Act or with the rules of the society, for such
purposes as may be specified in that behalf in the rules.
(2) The making, amendment, or recission of any regulations or bylaws
under any rules in accordance with this section shall not be deemed to be an
alteration of the rules under section 21.

Incorporated Societies Act 1908

SCHEDULE Section 7(a)

APPLICATION FOR INCORPORATION

975

We, the several persons whose names are subscribed hereto, being members of the above- mentioned society, hereby make application for the incorporation of the society under the Incorporated Societies Act 1908.

Dated this day of , 20 .

976 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

977

INQUEST ACT 1964

1964/23 – 1 December 1964

PART 6

RULES OF PROCEDURE FOR INQUEST IN RESPECT OF

DEATH AND INQUEST IN RESPECT OF FIRES AND

EXPLOSIONS

22 Inquest before Coroner alone

23 Date, place and notification of hearing

24 Procedure where criminal proceedings are

pending

25 Hearing in public and publication of

proceedings

26 Publication where death was self inflicted

27 Right of audience

28 Every kind of evidence admissible

29 Examination of witnesses

30 Protection of witnesses

31 Fees for witnesses

32 Default of witness and unauthorised

publication

33 Inquest may be completed by another

Coroner

34 Finding

35 Inquest may be reopened

36 Procedure so far as not prescribed

37 Mortuaries

PART 7

GENERAL

INQUIRIES AND INQUESTS IN RESPECT OF FIRE AND

EXPLOSIONS

18 Duty to report fires and explosions

19 Inquiries by Police and Coroner

20 When to hold inquest in respect of fires or

explosions

21 Purpose of inquest in respect of fires and

explosions

38 Power of Medical Officer to enter

39 Duty of Police to assist

40 Forms

41 Contempt

42 Offences

43 [Spent]

44 Application of fines

SCHEDULE


978 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

To provide for inquiries into the manner of death of any person into the cause and origin of fires and explosions

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Inquest Act 1964.

2 –

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“isolation station” means an isolation station appointed under the Public
Health Act;
“master” means and includes the owner of a ship and any person (except a
pilot) having command or charge of any ship;
“Medical Officer” means a person appointed by a Medical Officer to have
in his custody a person of unsound mind under Part 26 of the Niue Act
1966;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of the High Court and includes the Deputy
Registrar;
“ship” includes every description of vessel used in navigation, however
propelled, but does not include ships of the naval forces of any country.
PART 2
THE CORONER

4 Office of Coroner established

(1) Every person holding office as Judge, or Commissioner of the High
Court, or any 2 Justices of the Peace acting together shall, without any authority
other than this section by virtue of holding any such office, be a Coroner for the
purposes of this Act.
(2) The Judge, when present, may execute the functions of Coroner or may
at any time request a Commissioner of the High Court to execute any of the
functions of a Coroner.
(3) Unless so requested –
(a) [Spent]
(b) A Commissioner of the High Court shall not execute the functions
of Coroner when the Judge is present.
(4) Every person being a Coroner and executing functions of a Coroner
under this section shall be deemed to be the Coroner within the meaning of this
Act.

5 Functions of Coroner

The principal functions of the Coroner shall be to make inquiries and hold
inquests in respect of the death of any person and of fires or explosions as required
by this Act.

6 Powers of Coroner and duties of Registrar

(1) For the purpose of discharging his functions the Coroner shall, in
addition to any particular power conferred on him by this Act, have and may
exercise and invoke all the powers, privileges, authorities, and immunities which
are possessed by a Judge in his ordinary jurisdiction including the power to punish
for contempt of the High Court as provided in section 41.

Inquest Act 1964

979
(2) Every order, direction, determination or decision given or made by the
Coroner under this Act shall be final.
(3) The Registrar shall keep the records of the Coroner ’s office and shall
issue summonses and warrants and perform all such other administrative duties
in respect of that office as the Coroner may direct.
PART 3
REPORTS AND INQUIRIES INTO DEATH

7 Duty to report death to Coroner

(1) Every Medical Officer, constable, and the officer in charge of any prison
or isolation station shall forthwith report to the Coroner the death of any person
who, while being held in the custody of any such officer respectively, has died on
Niue from any cause or has died from any cause or has disappeared in the
circumstances specified in section 12.
(2) Where a person (not being a person held in custody under subsection
(1)) has died on Niue a sudden death of which the cause is unknown or has died
on Niue and there is reasonable cause to suspect that that person has died either a
violent or unnatural death, every Medical Officer and every constable who is
present when that person dies or who finds that person lying dead or being
drowned shall forthwith report the death to the Coroner, and any other person so
being present or so finding the body shall forthwith notify any constable who
thereupon shall report the death to the Coroner.

8 Inquiries by Police and Coroner

(1) In each case where section 7 applies, the Chief Officer of Police shall
make such inquiries as he thinks necessary for the purposes of this Act or as may
be directed by the Coroner.
(2) On receipt of any report under section 7, the Coroner may direct any
such inquiries to be made as he thinks necessary.

9 Medical report

Whether or not an inquest is being held, the Coroner may at any time request
the Director of Health or any member of the Director of Health’s staff who has
recently attended the person into whose death the Coroner is inquiring, to supply
him with a report relating to the death of the deceased person.

10 Postmortem examination during inquiries

(1) In each case, where the Coroner is informed that a person (not being a
person held in the custody of any officer referred to in section 7(1)) has died a
sudden death of which the cause is unknown, he may authorise and request the
Director of Health to carry out a postmortem examination of the body and to
report the result to him in writing.
(2) If the Coroner, on receipt of any such report or of a report under section
9, or as a result of inquiries made under section 8 is satisfied that the death was
due to natural causes, he may decide not to hold an inquest.

11 Burial and exhumation

(1) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in an enactment for the time
being in force it shall not be unlawful to exhume the body of any person if the
Coroner orders, by writing under his hand, that body is to be exhumed for the
purpose of an inquiry or inquest being held or to be held under this Act.
980 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) Whether or not an inquest is being held, the Coroner may at any time, by writing under his hand, order the burial of the body of any person whose death has been reported to him under this Act or the burial of any body exhumed under an order under this section.
(3) As a condition of any order under this section the Coroner may prescribe such safety precautions as he thinks fit and every person who fails to comply with any such condition or does any act to hinder or prevent any such condition being complied with commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one month or to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

12 Duty to report death on board ship

(1) Where any loss of life occurs from any cause on or from any ship the
master shall report the occurrence –
(a) Forthwith when loss of life occurs on or near the coast or in the
roadstead of Niue;
(b) On arrival in the roadstead of Niue when loss of life has occurred
at sea since the ship last departed from the port of any country or
island other than Niue.
(2) Subsection (1) shall apply where a person disappears on or from any
ship and this Act shall be read subject to this subsection, where applicable, and
with the necessary modifications.
(3) Every report required under this section shall be made by the master
whether or not any other person is required by section 7(1) to report the same
occurrence.
(4) Every report required under this section shall be made by the master
to any constable who shall report the death to the Coroner and thereupon this
Part shall, so far as applicable, apply with all necessary modifications.
PART 4
INQUEST IN RESPECT OF DEATH

13 Holding of inquest compulsory

The Coroner shall hold an inquest in each case where he is informed that a
person –
(a) Has died on Niue from any cause while in the custody of a constable or of an officer of prisons; or
(b) Is found dead on Niue and there is reasonable cause to suspect that the person has died either a violent or unnatural death; or
(c) Has died on Niue a sudden death of which the cause is unknown and the Coroner has not proceeded as provided in section 8 (2), section 9, or section 10 or has so proceeded and, in the circumstances specified in section 10 is not satisfied that the death was due to natural causes; or
(d) Has died from any cause or disappeared in the circumstances
specified in section 12(1)(a) and either the ship is still on or near the
coast or in the roadstead of Niue, or any witness is in Niue.

14 Holding of inquest permissive

(1) In each case where the Coroner has received a report under Part 3, and
where the holding of an inquest is not required by section 13, the Coroner shall
hold an inquest if he considers an inquest to be necessary or desirable.

Inquest Act 1964

981
(2) If in the circumstances specified in section 12(1)(b), the Coroner decides not to hold an inquest he shall direct, as far as practicable, such inquiries to be made and such evidence to be taken as may assist in the holding of an inquest (if any) in any country other than Niue.

15 Purpose of inquest in respect of death

An inquest shall be held for the purpose of establishing –
(a) The fact that a person has died;
(b) The identity of the deceased person;
(c) When, where, and how the death occurred.

16 View of body

(1) Where in respect of the death of any person an inquiry or an inquest
under this Act is held it shall not be necessary for the Coroner to view the body of
the deceased person.
(2) No inquest shall be concluded unless the Coroner is satisfied that the
body in respect of which the inquest is being held has been viewed by some person
giving evidence at the inquest.
(3) Where a person has disappeared from any ship or the Coroner is
satisfied that the body is destroyed or irrecoverable in any other circumstances he
shall hold and conclude any inquest required under this Act and the provisions of
this Act shall, so far as applicable, apply to any such inquest subject to all necessary
modifications.

17 Postmortem examination during inquest

(1) At any time before the conclusion of an inquest, the Coroner may
authorise and direct the Director of Health to carry out a postmortem examination
of the body of the deceased person and, where necessary, to request an analyst or
pathologist to make an analysis as part of the postmortem examination.
(2) The Coroner may direct the payment of such fees as he may think fit
for an analysis so made by any person other than a Medical Officer and any such
fee shall be paid out of the public revenue of Niue.
(3) For the purposes of this section and section 10(1), the Coroner may
give such directions as he thinks fit to the disposal or removal of the body or any
part of it and every person who fails to comply with any such direction or who
does any act to hinder or prevent any such direction being complied with commits
an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding one month or to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
PART 5
INQUIRIES AND INQUESTS IN RESPECT OF FIRES AND EXPLOSIONS

18 Duty to report fires and explosions

(1) The Chief Officer of Police shall forthwith report to the Coroner every
case in which –
(a) Any building, store of goods, stack of copra, or growing crop is
destroyed or damaged by fire; or
(b) Any explosion occurs, whether or not bodily harm to any person
or damage to any property is caused by or as a result of such
explosion;
(c) By any fireworks bodily harm to any person or damage to any
property is caused, whether or not such fireworks are discharged
under a permit issued under the Fireworks Act 1958; or
(d) Any report required by subsection (2) is received by the Police.
982 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) The master shall report to any constable –
(a) Forthwith, every case in which any fire or explosion occurs on board
ship on or near the coast or in the roadstead of Niue;
(b) On arrival in the roadstead of Niue, every case in which any fire or
explosion has occurred at sea since the ship last departed from the
port of any country other than Niue and bodily harm has been
caused to any person by or as a result of any such fire or explosion.

19 Inquiries by Police and Coroner

(1) In each case where section 18 applies, the Chief Officer of Police shall
make such inquiries as he thinks necessary for the purposes of this Act or as may
be directed by the Coroner.
(2) On receipt of any report in section 18, the Coroner may direct any such
inquiries to be made as he thinks necessary.

20 When to hold inquest in respect of fires and explosions

(1) In each case where the Coroner has received a report under section 18
he shall hold an inquest if he considers an inquest to be necessary or desirable.
(2) If in the circumstances specified in section 18(2) (a) or (b) the Coroner
decides not to hold an inquest he shall direct, as far as practicable, such inquiries
to be made and such evidence to be taken as may assist in the holding of an inquest
(if any) in any country other than Niue.

21 Purpose of inquest in respect of fires and explosions

(1) An inquest shall be held for the purpose of establishing –
(a) The cause and origin of any fire; or
(b) The cause and origin of any explosion including the mode of storage
of any explosives involved in the explosion; and
(c) Any other matter in connection with the fire or explosion in respect
of which the inquest is being held and which the Coroner may
consider appropriate to that inquest.
(2) For the purposes of this section “explosives” includes any article of
which an explosive forms part and which is capable of destructive effect by way
of explosion.
PART 6
RULES OF PROCEDURE FOR INQUEST IN RESPECT OF DEATH AND INQUEST IN RESPECT OF
FIRES AND EXPLOSIONS

22 Inquest before Coroner alone

All inquests shall be held before the Coroner alone.

23 Date, place, and notification of hearing

(1) The Coroner shall fix the date, time, and place of the inquest and shall
give notice of it to the Chief Office of Police and such other persons as he may
determine.
(2) The Coroner may adjourn any proceedings before him from time to
time and from place to place as the circumstances of the case may necessitate.
(3) It shall be lawful to hold an inquest on a Sunday whenever in the opinion
of the Coroner it is expedient so to do.

Inquest Act 1964

983

24 Procedure where criminal proceedings are pending

(1) If, before an inquest has been concluded, the Coroner is informed that
some person has been charged with causing the death or, as the case may be, the
fire or explosion in respect of which the inquest being held, and in the opinion of
the Coroner the result of the charge may have a material bearing on the inquest,
he shall adjourn the inquest until the criminal proceedings are terminated.
(2) For the purposes of this section “criminal proceedings” means any
proceedings within the criminal jurisdiction of the High Court and criminal
proceedings before the High Court shall not be deemed to be terminated until
leave to appeal can no longer be granted.
(3) On the termination of the criminal proceedings –
(a) If it appears to the Coroner that not all the facts and circumstances
specified in section 15 or section 21 have been established he shall
resume the inquest;
(b) If it appears to the Coroner that all those facts and circumstances
have been established, he may decide not to resume the inquest.
(4) If the adjourned inquest is an inquest in respect of the death of any
person and the Coroner decides not to resume the inquest as aforesaid, he shall
notify the Registrar of Births and Deaths of his decision and the date of it and give
him all available particulars required to be registered by regulation 20 of the Births
and Deaths Registration Regulations 1984.

25 Hearing in public and publication of proceedings

(1) The court or other place in which the inquest is held shall be open to
the public.
(2) If the Coroner considers it desirable in the interest of decency or public
order or in order to expedite the accuracy and justice of his finding, he may exclude
any person from the whole or any part of the proceedings, or he may prohibit the
publication of any part of the evidence given at the inquest.

26 Publication where death was self inflicted

At any inquest in respect if the death of any person –
(a) Where it appears to the Coroner that death may have been self
inflicted, he may, at any stage of the inquest direct that no report,
or no further report of the proceedings shall be published until he
has made his finding;
(b) Where the Coroner finds that death was self inflicted, no report of
the proceedings of this inquest shall, without the authority of the
Coroner, be published other than the name, address, and occupation
of the deceased person, and the fact that the Coroner has held an
inquest and found that death was self inflicted.

27 Right of audience

The Coroner may admit any person who, in the opinion of the Coroner,
has a sufficient interest in the subject or result of the inquest to attend in person or
to be represented by an attorney or agent and to examine and cross-examine any
witness who gives evidence at the inquest.

28 Every kind of evidence admissible

In all proceedings under this Act the Coroner may admit any kind of
evidence that he considers necessary for the purpose of establishing any of the
matters referred to in section 15 or section 21.
984 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

29 Examination of witnesses

(1) The Coroner shall at the inquest examine on oath every person who
tenders his evidence respecting the facts in issue and all other persons whom he
thinks it expedient to examine and any person may be so examined whether or
not he has been summoned to attend as a witness.
(2) The oath administered to any person so examined shall be in the form
numbered 1 in the Schedule.
(3) (a) If no person admitted to examine and cross-examine witnesses
under section 27 objects, the Coroner may permit any witness to
give the whole or any part of his evidence by tendering a previously
prepared statement in writing and confirming the same on oath.
(b) A witness may be cross-examined on his evidence in any such
statement as if he had given that evidence orally at the inquest.
(4) The Coroner may direct that all or any witnesses other than the witness
under examination shall leave the place of hearing and remain outside until called
upon to give evidence at the inquest.
(5) The Coroner shall cause the evidence admitted by him at the inquest to
be put into writing and every evidence so put into writing or given in a previously
prepared statement in writing shall be read over to and signed by the witness and
by the Coroner.

30 Protection of witnesses

Every witness attending and giving evidence at any inquest shall have the
same privileges and immunities as witnesses in the Court.

31 Fees for witnesses

Such reasonable amount in respect of expenses and loss of time as the
Coroner deems fit to award shall be paid to any witness giving evidence at any
inquiry or inquest.

32 Default of witness and unauthorised publication

(1) Every witness on whom a summons is duly served requesting him to
attend at the inquest, who fails without sufficient excuse to appear or to produce
any document which he is so required to produce, and any person, whether
summoned to attend or not, who, being at the hearing and being required to give
evidence or to produce any document then in his possession refuses, without
sufficient excuse, to be sworn or to give evidence or to produce that document,
commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5
penalty units.
(2) Every person who publishes –
(a) A report of any proceeding in contravention of this Act; or
(b) Any question at any inquest which the Coroner –
(i) has forbidden or disallowed; or
(ii) has warned the witness he is not obliged to answer, and has
ordered shall not be published;
commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5
penalty units.

33 Inquest may be completed by another Coroner

Where a Coroner has commenced an inquest and dies or is incapacitated
by illness, absence, or other sufficient cause from completing the inquest, the
inquest may be completed by another Coroner who may act upon any evidence
already given at the inquest in all respects as if it were given before him.

Inquest Act 1964

985

34 Finding

(1) After considering all the evidence before him at the inquest the Coroner
shall give his finding and shall sign a certificate in the form numbered 2A or 2B
(as the case may be) in the Schedule.
(2) Certified copies of every certificate shall be forwarded to Cabinet and
if the finding is given at the conclusion of an inquest in respect of the death of any
person, also to the Registrar of Births and Deaths.

35 Inquest may be reopened

(1) Where an inquest has been concluded and it is shown to the satisfaction
of the Coroner that material evidence has been discovered which was not known
or tendered at the inquest, or that the finding was based on any false or misleading
evidence, or that the finding was defective or erroneous for any other reason, he
may reopen the inquest and accept any part of the evidence given at the original
inquest which appears to him correct, and conduct such further inquiries as may
appear to him necessary.
(2) At the conclusion of the reopened inquest the Coroner shall give his
finding as provided in section 34 and any such finding shall for all purposes replace
the finding previously given.

36 Procedure so far as not prescribed

Subject to this Act the practice and procedure of the Coroner in the exercise
of his functions and powers shall be such as he thinks in each case to be most
consistent with natural justice and convenience.

37 Mortuaries

PART 7
GENERAL
Cabinet shall establish and maintain such places as may be necessary for the reception of dead bodies pending removal for burial or postmortem examination and shall provide facilities for carrying out in such places post mortem examinations under this Act.

38 Power of Medical Officer to enter

Every Medical Officer shall have power to enter any dwelling, building,
premises, land, ship or any other place and execute in it any duties imposed on
him by or under this Act.

39 Duty of Police to assist

It shall be the duty –
(a) Of the Chief of Police to assist at all inquests, inquiries, and
investigations held or made by the Coroner;
(b) Of every constable to give every Medical Officer any assistance he
may require in the execution of his duties under this Act and, when
requested, to accompany him to any such places the Medical Officer
may wish to enter as provided in section 38.

40 Forms

Save as provided in this Act all documents required or authorised in the
exercise of any power, function, or duty under this Act may be in such form as the
Coroner deems sufficient.
986 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

41 Contempt

(1) Section 101 of the Niue Act 1966 shall, with all necessary modifications,
apply to any proceedings of or before the Coroner under this Act as if such
proceedings were proceedings of or before the Court.
(2) Every person who commits an offence under subsection (1) shall be
liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or a fine not exceeding
1 penalty unit as provided in this section.
(3) The offence of contempt shall be punishable either –
(a) By the Court in the ordinary course of the criminal jurisdiction of
that Court; or
(b) Under subsections (4) and (5).
(4) If the contempt is committed in the presence or hearing of the Coroner,
the Coroner then and there holding an inquest may, without order or warrant,
direct any constable or other person to arrest the person so guilty of contempt and
bring him before the Coroner.
(5) The Coroner may thereupon, after giving the person so arrested a
reasonable opportunity of being heard in his defence, either order him to pay a
fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit or commit him to prison for any period not
exceeding 6 months.
(6) A person imprisoned for contempt or for default in payment of a fine
imposed upon him for contempt, may be at any time discharged by order of the
Coroner and any fine so imposed may be at any time remitted in whole or in part
in the same manner.

42 Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence who –
(a) Fails to comply with any direction given to him by the Coroner or
any Medical Officer under this Act; or
(b) Fails to comply with any duty or obligation imposed on him by
this Act; or
(c) Wilfully obstructs, hinders, or resists any person in the exercise or
execution of any power, duty, or function conferred or imposed on
such person by this Act; or
(d) Deceives or attempts to deceive any such person as aforesaid; or
(e) Does or omits, or causes or knowingly permits or suffers to be done
or omitted, any act, matter, or thing contrary to this Act; or
(f) Wilfully makes any false or misleading statement or any material
omission in any information or report to the Police or any Medical
Officer.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no
penalty is provided in this Act elsewhere than in this section or in the Niue Act
1966, is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
(3) Where the provisions of this Act impose on 2 or more persons the duty
to report one and the same occurrence to the Police, each of such persons shall be
responsible for making the report as required.
(4) If any of the persons being so responsible furnishes the required report
the other person or persons shall not be guilty of the offence of failing to comply
with any duty or obligation imposed on him by this Act.

43 [Spent]

Inquest Act 1964

987

44 Application of fines

All fines paid under this Act shall form part of the public revenues of Niue and shall be paid into the appropriate account.
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE

Form No. 1

Oath of Witness

Do you swear by Almighty God that the evidence which you shall give at this inquest in respect of the death of ................................................................................................................. . the disappearance at sea of .......................................................................................................... the fire at ........................................................................................................................................ the explosion at ............................................................................................................................ . shall be the truth, the whole truth and nothing but the truth.

–––––––––––––– Form No 2A (Death)

I ...................................................................... Coroner hereby certify that at an inquest concluded on the ............................ day of .................................................................. .20 ......... at ...................................................................... having inquired when, where and how

...................................... came to his death

......................... came to disappear at sea

I found ............................................................................................................................................ Dated at ..................................... this ...................... day of ....................... 20 ...........

.......................................................................................

Coroner

Form No 2B (Fire or Explosion) Finding of Coroner

I ..................................... Coroner hereby certify that an inquest concluded on the .............

........................... day of ............................................................... 20 .................... at…, having

inquired into the cause and origin of the fire at ..........................

the explosion at ............................................................................................................................

I found ...........................................................................................................................................

Dated at ..................................... this ...................... day of ....................... 20 ...........

................................................................................
Coroner

988 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

989

INTERNATIONAL FINANCE AGREEMENTS ACT 1961

Act 3 of 1961 (NZ) – 16 August 1961

[This Act as a whole was not made Niue law, but section 8 of the Act made specific provisions of the Act Niue law. Those provisions are set out here.]

––––––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 1

Article VIII, section 2

....

(b) Exchange contracts which involve the currency of any member and which

are contrary to the exchange control regulations of that member

maintained or imposed consistently with this Agreement shall be

unenforceable in the territories of any member. In addition, members may,

by mutual accord, cooperate in measures for the purpose of making the

exchange control regulations of either member more effective, provided

that such measures and regulations are consistent with this Agreement.

Article IX, sections 2-9

Status, Immunities and Privileges of the IMF

SECTION 2 – STATUS OF THE FUND

The Fund shall possess full juridical personality, and, in particular, the capacity –

(i) To contract;

(ii) To acquire and dispose of immovable and movable property;

(iii) To institute legal proceedings.

SECTION 3 - IMMUNITY FROM JUDICIAL PROCESS

The Fund, its property and its assets, wherever located and by whomsoever held,

shall enjoy immunity from every form of judicial process except to the extent that it

expressly waives its immunity for the purpose of any proceedings or by the terms of any

contract.

SECTION 4 - IMMUNITY FROM OTHER ACTION

Property and assets of the Fund, wherever located and by whomsoever held, shall

be immune from search, requisition, confiscation, expropriation or any other form of

seizure by executive or legislative action.

SECTION 5 - IMMUNITY OF ARCHIVES

The archives of the Fund shall be inviolable.

SECTION 6 - FREEDOM OF ASSETS FROM RESTRICTIONS

To the extent necessary to carry out the operations provided for in this Agreement,

all property and assets of the Fund shall be free from restrictions, regulations, controls

and moratoria of any nature.

990 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

SECTION 7 - PRIVILEGE FOR COMMUNICATIONS

The official communications of the Fund shall be accorded by members the same

treatment as the official communications of other members.

Fund –

SECTION 8 - IMMUNITIES AND PRIVILEGES OF OFFICERS AND EMPLOYEES

All Governors, Executive Directors, Alternates, officers and employees of the

(i) shall be immune from legal process with respect to acts performed by them in their official capacity, except when the Fund waives this immunity;

(ii) not being local nationals, shall be granted the same immunities from immigration restrictions, alien registration requirements and national service obligations and the same facilities as regards exchange restrictions as are accorded by members to the representatives, officials, and employees of comparable rank of other members;

(iii) shall be granted the same treatment in respect of travelling facilities as is accorded by members to representatives, officials and employees of comparable rank of other members.

SECTION 9 - IMMUNITIES FROM TAXATION

(a) The Fund, its assets, property, income and its operations and transactions

authorised by this Agreement shall be immune from all taxation and from

all customs duties. The Fund shall also be immune from liability for the

collection or payment of any tax or duty.

(b) No tax shall be levied on or in respect of salaries and emoluments paid

by the Fund to Executive Directors, Alternates, officers or employees of

the Fund who are not local citizens, local subjects, or other local nationals.

(c) No taxation of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security issued

by the Fund, including any dividend or interest thereon, by whomsoever

held –

(i) which discriminates against such obligation or security solely because

of its origin; or

(ii) if the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the place or currency

in which it is issued, made payable or paid, or the location of any

office or place of business maintained by the Fund.

SCHEDULE 2

Article VII, sections 2-9

Statutes, Immunities and Privileges of the IBRD

SECTION 2 - STATUS OF THE BANK

The Bank shall possess full juridical personality, and, in particular, the capacity –

(i) to contract;

(ii) to acquire and dispose of immovable and moveable property;

(iii) to institute legal proceedings.

SECTION 3 - POSITION OF THE BANK WITH REGARD TO JUDICIAL PROCESS

Actions may be brought against the Bank only in a Court of competent jurisdiction

in the territories of a member in which the Bank has an office, has appointed an agent for

the purpose of accepting service or notice of process, or has issued or guaranteed securities.

No actions shall, however, be brought by members or persons acting for or deriving claims

from members. The property and assets of the Bank shall, wheresoever located and by

whomsoever held, by immune from all forms of seizure, attachment or execution before

the delivery of final judgment against the Bank.

International Finance Agreements Act 1961

991

SECTION 4 - IMMUNITY OF ASSETS FROM SEIZURE

Property and assets of the Bank, wherever located and by whomsoever held, shall

be immune from search, requisition, confiscation, expropriation or any other form of

seizure by executive or legislative action.

SECTION 5 - IMMUNITY OF ARCHIVES

The archives of the Bank shall be inviolable.

SECTION 6 - FREEDOM OF ASSETS FROM RESTRICTIONS

To the extent necessary to carry out the operations provided for in this Agreement

and subject to the provisions of this Agreement, all property and assets of the Bank shall

be free from restrictions, regulations, controls and moratoria of any nature.

SECTION 7 - PRIVILEGE FOR COMMUNICATIONS

The official communications of the Bank shall be accorded by each member the

same treatment that it accords to the official communications of other members.

SECTION 8 - IMMUNITIES AND PRIVILEGES OF OFFICERS AND EMPLOYEES

All Governors, Executive Directors, Alternates, officers and employees of the Bank

(i) Shall be immune from legal process with respect to acts performed

by them in their official capacity except when the Bank waives this

immunity;

(ii) Not being local nationals, shall be accorded the same immunities

from immigration restrictions, alien registration requirements and

national service obligations and the same facilities as regards

exchange restrictions as are accorded by members to the

representatives, officials and employees of comparable rank of other

members;

(iii) Shall be granted the same treatment in respect of travelling facilities

as is accorded by members to representatives, officials and employees

of comparable rank of other members.

SECTION 9 - IMMUNITIES FROM TAXATION

(a) The Bank, its assets, property, income and its operations and transactions

authorised by this Agreement, shall be immune from all taxation and

from all customs duties. The Bank shall also be immune from liability for

the collection or payment of any tax or duty.

(b) No tax shall be levied on or in respect of salaries and emoluments paid

by the Bank to Executive Directors, Alternates, officials or employees of

the Bank who are not local citizens, local subjects, or other local nationals.

(c) No taxation of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security issued

by the Bank (including any dividend or interest thereon) by whomsoever

held –

(i) Which discriminates against such obligation or security solely

because it is issued by the Bank; or

(ii) If the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the place or currency

in which it is issued, made payable or paid, or the location of any

office or place of business maintained by the Bank.

(d) No taxation of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security

guaranteed by the Bank (including any dividend or interest thereon) by

whomsoever held –

(i) Which discriminates against such obligation or security solely

because it is guaranteed by the Bank; or

(ii) If the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the location of any

office or place of business maintained by the Bank.


992 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

SCHEDULE 3

Article VI, sections 2-9 and 11

Status, Immunities and Privileges of the IFC

SECTION 2 - STATUS OF THE CORPORATION

The Corporation shall possess full juridical personality and, in particular, the

capacity –

(i) to contract;

(ii) to acquire and dispose of immovable and movable property;

(iii) to institute legal proceedings.

SECTION 3 - POSITION OF THE CORPORATION WITH REGARD TO JUDICIAL PROCESS

Actions may be brought against the Corporation only in a Court of competent

jurisdiction in the territories of a member in which the Corporation has an office, has

appointed an agent for the purpose of accepting service or notice of process, or has issued

or guaranteed securities. No actions shall, however, be brought by members or persons

acting for or deriving claims from members. The property and assets of the Corporation

shall, wheresoever located and by whomsoever held, be immune from all forms of seizure,

attachment or execution before the delivery of final judgment against the Corporation.

SECTION 4 - IMMUNITY OF ASSETS FROM SEIZURE

Property and assets of the Corporation, wherever located and by whomsoever

held, shall be immune from search, requisition, confiscation, expropriation or any other

form of seizure by executive or legislative action.

SECTION 5 - IMMUNITY OF ARCHIVES

The archives of the Corporation shall be inviolable.

SECTION 6 - FREEDOM OF ASSETS FROM RESTRICTIONS

To the extent necessary to carry out the operations provided for in this Agreement

and subject to the provisions of Article III, section 5, and the other provisions of this

Agreement, all property and assets of the Corporation shall be free from restrictions,

regulations, controls and moratoria of any nature.

SECTION 7 – PRIVILEGE FOR COMMUNICATIONS

The official communications of the Corporation shall be accorded by each member

the same treatment that it accords to the official communications of other members.

SECTION 8 - IMMUNITIES AND PRIVILEGES OF OFFICERS AND EMPLOYEES

All Governors, Directors, Alternates, officers and employees of the Corporation –

(i) shall be immune from legal process with respect to acts performed

by them in their official capacity;

(ii) not being local nationals, shall be accorded the same immunities from

immigration restrictions, alien registration requirements and national

service obligations and the same facilities as regards exchange

restrictions as are accorded by members to the representatives,

officials and employees of comparable rank of other members;

(iii) shall be granted the same treatment in respect of travelling facilities

as is accorded by members to representatives, officials and employees

of comparable rank of other members.

SECTION 9 - IMMUNITIES FROM TAXATION

(a) The Corporation, its assets, property, income, and its operations and

transactions authorised by this Agreement, shall be immune from all

taxation and from all customs duties. The Corporation shall also be

immune from liability for the collection or payment of any tax or duty.

International Finance Agreements Act 1961

993

(b) No tax shall be levied on or in respect of salaries and emoluments paid by the Corporation to Directors, Alternates, officials or employees of the Corporation who are not local citizens, local subjects, or other local nationals.

(c) No taxation of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security issued by the Corporation (including any dividend or interest thereon) by whomsoever held –

(i) which discriminates against such obligation or security solely because it is issued by the Corporation; or

(ii) if the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the place or currency in which it is issued, made payable or paid, or the location of any office or place of business maintained by the Corporation.

(d) No taxation of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security guaranteed by the Corporation (including any dividend or interest thereon) by whomsoever held –

(i) which discriminates against such obligation or security solely because it is guaranteed by the Corporation; or

(ii) if the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the location of any office or place of business maintained by the Corporation.

SECTION 11 – WAIVER

The Corporation in its discretion may waive any of the privileges and immunities

conferred under this Article to such extent and upon such conditions as it may determine.

994 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

995

INTERNATIONAL FINANCE AGREEMENTS AMENDMENT ACT 1966

Act 26 of 1966 (NZ) – 16 September 1966

[This Act as a whole was not made Niue law, but sections 3, 4 and 5 of the Act made specific provisions of the Act Niue law. Those provisions are set out here.]

–––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 1
Chapter VIII, articles 49-56 and 58
Status, Immunities, Exemptions and Privileges of the ADB
ARTICLE 49 – LEGAL STATUS
The Bank shall possess full juridical personality and, in particular, full
capacity –
(i) to contract;
(ii) to acquire, and dispose of, immovable and movable property;
and
(iii) to institute legal proceedings.
ARTICLE 50 – IMMUNITY FROM JUDICIAL PROCEEDINGS
1 The Bank shall enjoy immunity from every form of legal process, except in
cases arising out of or in connection with the exercise of its powers to borrow
money, to guarantee obligations, or to buy and sell or underwrite the sale of
securities, in which cases actions may be brought against the Bank in a court of
competent jurisdiction in the territory of a country in which the Bank has its
principal or a branch office, or has appointed an agent for the purpose of accepting
service or notice of process, or has issued or guaranteed securities.
2 Notwithstanding the provisions of paragraph 1 of this Article, no action
shall be brought against the Bank by any member, or by any agency or
instrumentality of a member, or by any entity or person directly or indirectly acting
for or deriving claims from a member or from any agency or instrumentality of a
member. Members shall have recourse to such special procedures for the settlement
of controversies between the Bank and its members as may be prescribed in this
Agreement, in the bylaws and regulations of the Bank, or in contracts entered into
with the Bank.
3 Property and assets of the Bank shall, wheresoever located and by
whomsoever held, be immune from all forms of seizure, attachment or execution
before the delivery of final judgments against the Bank.
ARTICLE 51 – IMMUNITY OF ASSETS
Property and assets of the Bank, wheresoever located and by whomsoever
held, shall be immune from search, requisition, confiscation, expropriation or any
other form of taking or foreclosure by executive or legislative action.
996 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
ARTICLE 52 – IMMUNITY OF ARCHIVES
The archives of the Bank and, in general, all documents belonging to it, or
held by it, shall be inviolable, wherever located.
ARTICLE 53 – FREEDOM OF ASSETS FROM RESTRICTIONS
To the extent necessary to carry out the purpose and functions of the Bank
effectively, and subject to the provisions of this Agreement, all property and assets
of the Bank shall be free from restrictions, regulations, controls and moratoria of
any nature.
ARTICLE 54 – PRIVILEGE FOR COMMUNICATIONS
Official communications of the Bank shall be accorded by each member
treatment not less favourable than that it accords to the official communications
of any other member.
ARTICLE 55 – IMMUNITIES AND PRIVILEGES OF BANK PERSONNEL
All Governors, Directors, Alternates, officers and employees of the Bank,
including experts performing missions for the Bank:
(i) shall be immune from legal process with respect to acts
performed by them in their official capacity, except when the
Bank waives the immunity;
(ii) where they are not local citizens or nationals, shall be accorded
the same immunities from immigration restrictions, alien
registration requirements and national service obligations, and
the same facilities as regards exchange regulations, as are
accorded by members to the representatives, officials and
employees of comparable rank of other members; and
(iii) shall be granted the same treatment in respect of travelling
facilities as is accorded by members to representatives, officials
and employees of comparable rank of other members.
ARTICLE 56 – EXEMPTION FROM TAXATION
1 The Bank, its assets, property, income and its operations and transactions,
shall be exempt from all taxation and from all customs duties. The Bank shall also
be exempt from any obligation for the payment, withholding or collection of any
tax or duty.
2 No tax shall be levied on or in respect of salaries and emoluments paid by
the Bank to Directors, Alternates, officers or employees of the Bank, including
experts performing missions for the Bank, except where a member deposits with
its instrument of ratification or acceptance a declaration that such member retains
for itself and its political subdivisions the right to tax salaries and emoluments
paid by the Bank to citizens or nationals of such member.
3 No tax of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security issued by
the Bank, including any dividend or interest thereon, by whomsoever held –
(i) which discriminates against such obligation or security solely
because it is issued by the Bank; or
(ii) if the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the place or
currency in which it is issued, made payable or paid, or the
location of any office or place of business maintained by the
Bank.
4 No tax of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security guaranteed
by the Bank, including any dividend or interest thereon, by whomsoever held –

International Finance Agreements Amendment Act 1966

997
(i) which discriminates against such obligation or security solely because it is guaranteed by the Bank; or
(ii) if the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the location of any office or place of business maintained by the Bank.
ARTICLE 58 – WAIVER OF IMMUNITIES, EXEMPTIONS AND PRIVILEGES
The Bank at its discretion may waive any of the privileges, immunities and
exemptions conferred under this Chapter in any case or instance, in such manner
and upon such conditions as it may determine to be appropriate in the best interests
of the Bank.
–––––––––––––––
SCHEDULE 2
Article VIII, sections 2-9
Status, Immunities and Privileges of the IDA
SECTION 2 – STATUS OF THE ASSOCIATION
The Association shall possess full juridical personality and, in particular,
the capacity –
(i) to contract;
(ii) to acquire and dispose of immovable and movable property;
(iii) to institute legal proceedings.
SECTION 3 – POSITION OF THE ASSOCIATION WITH REGARD TO JUDICIAL PROCESS
Actions may be brought against the Association only in a court of competent
jurisdiction in the territories of a member in which the Association has an office,
has appointed an agent for the purpose of accepting service or notice of process,
or has issued or guaranteed securities. No actions shall, however, be brought by
members or persons acting for or deriving claims from members. The property
and assets of the Association shall, wheresoever located and by whomsoever held,
be immune from all forms of seizure, attachment or execution before the delivery
of final judgment against the Association.
SECTION 4 – IMMUNITY OF ASSETS FROM SEIZURE
Property and assets of the Association, wherever located and by
whomsoever held, shall be immune from search, requisition, confiscation,
expropriation or any other form of seizure by executive or legislative action.
SECTION 5 – IMMUNITY OF ARCHIVES
The archives of the Association shall be inviolable.
SECTION 6 – FREEDOM OF ASSETS FROM RESTRICTIONS
To the extent necessary to carry out the operations provided for in this
Agreement and subject to the provisions of this Agreement, all property and assets
of the Association shall be free from restrictions, regulations, controls and moratoria
of any nature.
SECTION 7 – PRIVILEGE FOR COMMUNICATIONS
The official communications of the Association shall be accorded by each
member of the same treatment that it accords to the official communications of
other members.
998 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
SECTION 8 – IMMUNITIES AND PRIVILEGES OF OFFICERS AND EMPLOYEes
All Governors, Executive Directors, Alternates, officers and employees of
the Association –
(i) shall be immune from legal process with respect to acts
performed by them in their official capacity except when the
Association waives this immunity;
(ii) not being local nationals shall be accorded the same immunities
from immigration restrictions, alien registration requirements
and national service obligations and the same facilities as
regards exchange restrictions as are accorded by members to
the representatives, officials and employees of comparable rank
of other members;
(iii) shall be granted the same treatment in respect of travelling
facilities as is accorded by members to representatives, officials
and employees of comparable rank of other members.
SECTION 9 – IMMUNITIES FROM TAXATION
(a) The Association, its assets, property, income and its operations and
transactions authorised by this Agreement, shall be immune from
all taxation and from all customs duties. The Association shall also
be immune from liability for the collection or payment of any tax
or duty.
(b) No tax shall be levied on or in respect of salaries and emoluments
paid by the Association to Executive Directors, Alternates, officials
or employees of the Association who are not local citizens, local
subjects, or other local nationals.
(c) No taxation of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security
issued by the Association (including any dividend or interest
thereon) by whomsoever held –
(i) which discriminates against such obligation or security solely
because it is issued by the Association; or
(ii) if the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the place or
currency in which it is issued, made payable or paid, or the
location of any office or place of business maintained by the
Association.
(d) No taxation of any kind shall be levied on any obligation or security
guaranteed by the Association (including any dividend or interest
thereon) by whomsoever held –
(i) which discriminates against such obligation or security solely
because it is guaranteed by the Association; or
(ii) if the sole jurisdictional basis for such taxation is the location
of any office or place of business maintained by the Association.
999

INTERPRETATION ACT 2004

2004/269

PART 1

18

Enactments made under repealed

GENERAL

legislation to have continuing effect

1

Name

19

Powers exercised under the repealed

2

Purposes

legislation to have continuing effect

3

Application

20

References to repealed enactment

4

Sources of law

21

Amending enactment part of enactment

5

Definitions

amended

22

Regulations

PART 2

23

Power to make regulations

PRINCIPLES OF INTERPRETATION

24

Enactments not binding on the

6

Ascertaining meaning of legislation

Government

7

Enactments do not have retrospective effect

PART 4

PART 3

MISCELLANEOUS

LEGISLATION 25 Use of forms

8

Date of commencement

26

Bodies corporate

9

Time of commencement

27

Parts of speech and grammatical forms

10

Exercise of powers between passing and

28

Number

commencement of legislation

29

Calendar and standard time

11

Power to appoint to an office

30

Calculation of time

12

Power to correct errors

31

Distances

13

Exercise of powers by deputies

32

Thumbprint or mark in lieu of signature

14

Exercise of powers and duties

33

Electronically recorded documents

15

Effect of repeal generally

34

Currency

16

Effect of repeal on enforcement of existing

35

Publication

rights

36-3

7 [Spent]

17

Effect of repeal on prior offences and

breaches of enactments

Relating to the interpretation, application, and effect of legislation and public documents

1 Name

PART 1
GENERAL
This is the Interpretation Act 2004.

2 Purposes

The purposes of this Act are—
(a) To state principles and rules for the interpretation of legislation and
public documents;
1000 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(b) To shorten legislation and public documents; and
(c) To promote consistency in the language and form of legislation and
public documents.

3 Application

(1) This Act applies to an enactment that is part of the law of Niue and to
a public document of Niue, whether passed, or written, before or after the
commencement of this Act unless—
(a) The enactment provides otherwise; or
(b) The context of the enactment or public document requires a different
interpretation.
(2) The provisions of this Act also apply to the interpretation of this Act.
(3) This Act binds the Government.

4 Sources of law

The sources of Niuean law are, in order of priority—
(a) The Constitution;
(b) Acts of the Assembly;
(c) Regulations;
(d) Niuean custom;
(e) The common law of Niue.

5 Definitions

In any enactment and public document—
“Assembly” has the same meaning as in article 82(1) of the Constitution;
“Commission” means the Niue Public Service Commission;
“Commonwealth country” or “part of the Commonwealth” means a
country that is a member of the Commonwealth, and includes a territory
for the international relations of which the member is responsible;
“constable” means an officer of police of the Niue Public Service;
“Constitution” means the Constitution of Niue, and includes the Act of the
Parliament of New Zealand intituled the Niue Constitution Act 1974,
and also includes any constitutional amendment, as that term is used
in article 35 of the Constitution, when that constitutional amendment
has come into force;
“Court” means the High Court;
“day” means a calendar day;
“document” includes any publication and any matter written, expressed
or described on any substance by means of letters, figures or marks;
“enactment” has the same meaning as in article 82(1) of the Constitution;
“financial year” means a period of twelve months ending on 30 June;
“Government” means the Government of Niue;
“holiday” means Sunday, Christmas Day, Boxing Day, New Year ’s Day, 2
January, Good Friday, Easter Monday, 25 April, the Sovereign’s Birthday,
the third Monday and Tuesday of October, the fourth Monday of
October, and any day declared by the Cabinet as a public holiday;
“Judge” has the same meaning as in article 82(1) of the Constitution;
“judgment” includes any judicial decree, order, or determination, whether
in an action or in any other judicial proceeding, whether civil or criminal;
“mangafaoa” has the same meaning as in the Land Act 1969;
“Minister” means the Minister to whom responsibility for the department
or subject to which the context refers has been assigned;

Interpretation Act 2004

1001
“month” means a calendar month;
“New Zealand” when used as a territorial description, means the islands
and territories within the Realm of New Zealand but does not include
Niue, Tokelau, the Cook Islands, or the Ross Dependency;
“Niue” when used as territorial description, means the island of Niue and
the territorial sea;
“Niuean” means a person belonging to the aboriginal race of Niue, and
includes a person descended from a Niuean;
“owner”, in relation to Niuean land other than land held under lease or
licence as defined in the Land Act 1969, means the mangafaoa or a
member of the mangafaoa;
“penalty unit” means one hundred dollars ($100.00);
“person” or any term descriptive of a person includes a corporation sole, a
body corporate, and an unincorporated body;
“prescribed” means prescribed by or under an enactment;
“public place” means any road, any place open to or used by the public as
of right, any wharf or jetty, any vessel at a wharf or jetty or within one
mile of the shore, and any church or other building where divine service
is being publicly held, any hall or room in which any public
entertainment is being held, and any market place;
“public notice” means making an act , matter or thing generally known in
Niue by any customary and practicable means, or by publication in the

Niue Gazette;

“regulation” means any enactment other than an Act, but does not include
regulations made by an authority which has jurisdiction limited to a
district or village;
“repeal”, in relation to an enactment, includes expiry, revocation, and
replacement;
“rules of court”, in relation to a court, means rules or regulations governing
the practice or procedure of the court in question and made by the
proper authority in that behalf;
“territorial sea” has the same meaning as in section 4 of the Territorial Sea
and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1977;
“working day” means a day of the week other than a Saturday or a holiday;
“writing” includes representing or reproducing words, figures, or
symbols—
(i) In a visible and tangible form by any means and in any medium;
(ii) In a visible form in any medium by electronic means that
enables them to be stored in permanent form and to be retrieved
and read.
PART 2
PRINCIPLES OF INTERPRETATION

6 Ascertaining meaning of legislation

(1) The meaning of an enactment must be ascertained from its text, in light
of its purpose and in its context.
(2) The matters that may be considered in ascertaining the meaning of an
enactment include the indications provided in the enactment.
(3) Examples of those indicators are preambles, the analyses, tables of
contents, headings to Parts and sections, marginal notes, diagrams, graphics,
examples and explanatory material, and the organisation and format of the
enactment.
1002 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

7 Enactments do not have retrospective effect

An enactment does not have retrospective effect.

8 Date of commencement

PART 3
LEGISLATION
(1) An enactment comes into force on the date stated or provided in the enactment.
(2) If an enactment does not state or provide for a commencement date,
the enactment comes into force on the date of its certification and sealing, or in the
case of a regulation, on the day on which it is made.

9 Time of commencement

(1) An enactment comes into force at the beginning of the day on which
the enactment comes into force.
(2) If an enactment is expressed to come into force from a particular day,
the enactment comes into force at the beginning of the next day.

10 Exercise of powers between passing and commencement of legislation

(1) A power conferred by an enactment may be exercised before the
enactment comes into force to—
(a) Make a regulation or rule or other instrument;
(b) Serve a notice or document;
(c) Appoint a person to an office or position;
(d) Establish a body of persons; or
(e) Do any other act or thing for the purposes of the enactment.
The power may be exercised only if the exercise of the power is necessary or
desirable to bring, or in connection with bringing, an enactment into operation.
(3) The power may not be exercised if anything that results from exercising
the power comes into force before the enactment itself comes into force unless the
exercise of the power is necessary or desirable to bring, or in connection with
bringing, the enactment into operation.
(4) Subsection (1) applies as if the enactment under which the power is
exercised and any other enactment that is not in force when the power is exercised
were in force when the power is exercised.

11 Power to appoint to an office

The power to appoint a person to an office includes the power to –
(a) Remove or suspend a person from the office;
(b) Reappoint or reinstate a person to the office;
(c) Appoint another person in the place of a person who –
(i) Has vacated the office;
(ii) Has died;
(iii) Is absent; or
(iv) Is incapacitated in a way that affects the performance of the
office.

12 Power to correct errors

The power to make an appointment or do any other act or thing may be
exercised to correct an error or omission in a previous exercise of the power even
though the power is not generally capable of being exercised more than once.

Interpretation Act 2004

1003

13 Exercise of powers by deputies

A power conferred on the holder of an office, other than a Minister, may be
exercised by the holder ’s deputy lawfully acting in the office.

14 Exercise of powers and duties

Where an enactment confers a power or imposes a duty –
(a) The power may be exercised and the duty shall be performed as
occasion requires;
(b) An act done in the exercise of the power may be cancelled or varied
in the same manner as the power was exercised.

15 Effect of repeal generally

(1) The repeal of an enactment does not affect –
(a) The validity, invalidity, effect, or consequences of anything done or
suffered;
(b) An existing right, interest, title, immunity, or duty;
(c) An existing status or capacity;
(d) An amendment made by the enactment to another enactment;
(e) The previous operation of the enactment or anything done or
suffered under it.
(2) The repeal of an enactment does not revive –
(a) An enactment that has been repealed or a rule of the law that has
been abolished;
(b) Any other thing that is not in force or existing at the time the repeal
takes effect.

16 Effect of repeal on enforcement of existing rights

(a) The repeal of an enactment does not affect the completion of a matter
or thing or the bringing or completion of proceedings that relate to
an existing right, interest, title, immunity or duty.
(b) A repealed enactment continues to have effect as if it had not been
repealed for the purpose of completing the matter or thing or bring
or completing the proceedings that relate to the existing right,
interest, title, immunity, or duty.

17 Effect of repeal on prior offences and breaches of enactments

(1) The repeal of an enactment does not affect a liability to a penalty for an
offence or for a breach of an enactment committed before the repeal.
(2) A repealed enactment continues to have effect as if it had not been
repealed for the purpose of –
(a) Investigating the offence or breach;
(b) Commencing or completing proceedings for the offence or breach;
(c) Imposing a penalty for the offence or breach.

18 Enactments made under repealed legislation to have continuing effect

(1) An enactment made under a repealed enactment, and which is in force
immediately before that repeal, continues in force as if it had been made under
any other enactment –
(a) Which, with or without modification, replaces, or corresponds to,
the enactment repealed, and
(b) Under which it could be made.
1004 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) An enactment that continues in force may be amended or revoked as if it had been made under the enactment that replaces, or that corresponds to, the repealed enactment.

19 Powers exercised under the repealed legislation to have continuing effect

Anything done in the exercise of a power under a repealed enactment, and
which is in effect immediately before that repeal, continues to have effect as if it
had been exercised under any other enactment –
(a) Which, with or without modification, replaces, or that corresponds
to, the enactment repealed; and
(b) Under which the power could be exercised.

20 References to repealed enactment

(1) The repeal of an enactment does not affect an enactment in which the
repealed enactment is applied, incorporated, or referred to.
(2) A reference in an enactment to a repealed enactment is a reference to
an enactment which, with or without modification, replaces, or corresponds to,
the enactment repealed.
(3) Subsection (1) is subject to subsection (2).

21 Amending enactment part of enactment amended

An amending enactment is part of the enactment it amends.

22 Regulations

(1) All regulations shall state the enactment under which they were made
and the date on which they were made.
(2) All regulations shall be laid before the Assembly at the first session of
the Assembly following their making.

23 Power to make regulations

Where an enactment confers powers to make regulations –
(a) If the regulations purport to be made in exercise of a particular
power, they shall also be construed to be made in exercise of every
other enabling power;
(b) The regulations may be amended in the same manner in which
they were made by the same person or by any other person on
whom the enactment confers the power to make the regulations;
(c) For general purposes and also for a special purpose, the special
purpose shall not derogate from the power conferred by the general
purpose provision.

24 Enactments not binding on the Government

No enactment binds the Government.

25 Use of forms

PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS
A form is not invalid because it contains minor differences from a prescribed form as long as the form has the same effect and is not misleading.

Interpretation Act 2004

1005

26 Bodies corporate

(1) Every body corporate shall –
(a) Have perpetual succession and a common seal;
(b) Have an office at such place as it may designate;
(c) Have the rights of a natural person of full age and capacity; and
(d) Carry on all such activities as may appear to it to be requisite,
advantageous, convenient or conducive to the attainment of its
objects.
(2) No member of a body corporate or of its controlling body who receives
any emoluments from the State shall be deemed to hold a public office by reason of their appointment.
(3) (a) A member of a body corporate may resign office on giving one
month’s written notice in that behalf to the person who has the
power of appointment.
(b) A member of a body corporate or of its controlling body who –
(i) has unreasonably absented themselves from a meeting of the
body corporate;
(ii) has become insolvent, has assigned their estate for the benefit
of the creditors or has made an arrangement with the creditors;
(iii) has been guilty of any misconduct or default in the discharge
of their duties as a member which, in the opinion of the person
who has the power of appointment, renders them unfit to be a
member;
(iv) has been convicted of an offence of such a nature as, in the
opinion of the person who has the power of appointment,
renders it desirable that the member should be removed from
office; or
(v) is suffering from such mental or physical infirmity as, in the
opinion of the person who has the power of appointment,
renders that member unfit to discharge their duties as a member
– may be removed from office or suspended by the person who has
the power of appointment.
(4) (a) Every body corporate shall sue and be sued in its corporate name.
(b) Service of any process by or on a body corporate shall be sufficient
if made on behalf of the chairperson.
(5) (a) Subject to paragraph (b), no document shall be executed by or on
behalf of a body corporate unless it is signed by the chairperson.
(b) Every cheque of a body corporate shall be signed by the chairperson
and treasurer.
(c) Notwithstanding paragraphs (a) and (b), every document to which
a body corporate is a party may be signed by any person nominated
for the purpose by the body corporate and shall, when so signed,
be deemed to be duly executed by or on behalf of the body corporate.
(6) Everything authorised or required to be done by a body corporate or
by its controlling body shall be decided by a simple majority of members present
and voting, or in accordance with subsections (9) and (10).
(7) At any meeting of a body corporate or of its controlling body, each
member shall have one vote on the matter in question and, in the event of an
equality of votes, the chairperson shall have a casting vote.
(8) A body corporate may delegate any of its powers to its controlling body.
(9) The linking by telephone or other means of telecommunication of a
number of the members of the body corporate not less than the quorum (whether
1006 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
or not any of the members are outside of Niue) shall be deemed to constitute a meeting of the body corporate, and all the rules of the body corporate shall apply to that meeting if –
(a) Each member has received at least two working days notice that there will be a meeting by telephone or other means of communication, and
(b) At the commencement of the meeting each member has acknowledged the presence of all other members taking part in the meeting, and
(c) Each member who takes part in the meeting is able throughout the meeting to hear each member who is taking part in the meeting.
(10) (a) A proposal in writing signed or assented to by letter, telegram, cable,
telex, facsimile or other written manner, by all members of the body
corporate or of its controlling body duly called and constituted shall
be a decision of the body corporate.
(b) A decision made under this paragraph may consist of several
documents in like form signed by any one or more of the members
of the body corporate.
(11) Subject to subsections (6), (7), (9), and (10), a body corporate shall
regulate its proceedings and those of its controlling body, committees and sub­
committees in such a manner as it thinks fit.

27 Parts of speech and grammatical forms

Parts of speech and grammatical forms of a word that is defined in an
enactment have corresponding meanings in the same enactment.

28 Number

Words in the singular include the plural and words in the plural include
the singular.

29 Calendar and standard time

(1) The calendar in Niue shall be one day behind the calendar in New
Zealand, so that the first day of January in Niue shall be the day which is coincident
for the most part with the second day of January in New Zealand, and so on from
day to day throughout the year.
(2) The standard time of Niue is the solar time of longitude 165 degrees
west of Greenwich.

30 Calculation of time

(1) A period of time described as beginning at, on, or with a specified day,
act, or event includes that day or the day of the act or event.
(2) A period of time described as beginning from or after a specified day,
act or event does not include that day or the day of the act or event.
(3) A period of time described as ending by, on, at, or with, or as continuing
to or until, a specified day, act, or event includes that day or the day or the act or
event.
(4) A period of time described as ending before a specified day, act or event does not include that day or the day of the act or event.
(5) A reference to a number of days between two events does not include the days on which the events happened.
(6) A thing that, under an enactment, must, or may be done on a particular day or within a limited period of time may, if that day or the last day of that period is not a working day, be done on the next working day.

Interpretation Act 2004

1007

31 Distances

A reference to a distance means a distance measured in a straight line on a
horizontal or vertical plane.

32 Thumbprint or mark in lieu of signature

Where a party to a document is unable to sign, the thumbprint or mark of
that party, attested by the signature of two other persons who are not parties to
the document and who certify the identity of the party affixing the thumbprint or
mark shall have the same legal effect as if that party has signed their name.

33 Electronically recorded documents

(1) Where an electronically recorded document bears, as evidence that the
document emanates from a particular individual, a personal identification mark,
the mark shall have the same legal effect as if the individual had signed their
name on the document.
(2) Where any matter is electronically recorded, a reference in any
enactment –
(a) To an original shall be construed as a reference to that record;
(b) To a true or certified copy, shall be construed as a reference to a
reprint of that record.

34 Currency

(1) The unit of currency of Niue is the New Zealand dollar.
(2) A tender of payment of money in New Zealand dollars is legal tender.

35 Publication

Public notice shall be given of all enactments and government
appointments, warrants, and instruments.

36-37 [Spent]

1008 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

1009

LAND ACT 1969

1969/57 – 1 November 1969

23

Application for confirmation

24

Orders of confirmation

25

Effect of confirmation

26

Conditions of confirmation

27

Confirmation of instruments in pursuance

of precedent contract

28

Alteration of instruments on confirmation

Leases

29

Leases of Niuean land not to exceed 60

years

30

Registrar may execute renewals

Occupation Orders

31

Court may make occupation orders

Security charges

32

Security charge over Niuean land

33

Appointment of Receiver

Partitions

34

Jurisdiction to partition Niuean land

35

Court may apportion rights and obligations

36

Discretionary powers of Court

37

Combination of several areas of land

38

Saving of interests charged on partitioned

land

39

Entries in Land Register

Exchanges

40

Court may make exchange orders

41

Conditions of exchange

42

Effect of order of exchange

Sales

43

Sale of Niuean land to the Crown

Reservations

44

Reservations for communal purposes

45

Revocation or variation of reservation

46

Management and control of reservations

PART 4

SURVEYS

47

Control and supervision of surveys

48

Authority for survey

1010 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

49

Authority to enter on land

52

Registrar ’s powers

50

Obstruction

53

Officers not personally liable

54

[Spent]

PART 5

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

41

Procedure for taking land for public

purposes

To provide for the control and tenure of land, the survey of land, the registration of title to land and other like purposes

1 Short title

This is the Land Act 1969.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“approved form” means a form approved by Cabinet;
“boundary mark” means any concrete peg or post, iron pipe, or spike in
rock or other survey mark or other fixture used to denote a boundary;
“Court” means the Land Court;
“dealing” means every transfer, transmission, charge, lease, encumbrance
or other alienation or transaction affecting any land or interest in land
under this Act;
“endorsement”, in addition to its ordinary meaning includes anything
written upon or at the foot of any document for giving effect to any of
the purposes of this Act;
“instrument” means any printed or written deed, map, plan or other dealing
affecting any land or interest in any land;
“Land Court” means the land division of the High Court;
“lease”, in relation to any Niuean land, includes, in addition to its ordinary
meaning, any licence, grant, or other alienation conferring upon any
person a right at law or in equity to the use or occupation of the land
for any purpose, or a right to enter on it for the purpose of removing
from it timber or any other valuable thing attached to or forming part
of it, whether that alienation confers a right of exclusive possession or
not;
“Mangafaoa” in relation to any Niuean land means the family or group of
persons descended from a common ancestor, including any person who
has been legally adopted into the family, who at any given time are
recognised as entitled by Niuean custom to any share or interest in the
land, and excludes a former member of the family legally adopted into
some other family. Where Niuean land is owned by a single person
exclusively, that person is the Mangafaoa of the land;
“owner” in relation to Niuean land other than land held under lease or
licence may be construed as reference to the Mangafaoa or a member
of the Mangafaoa;
“register” means to enter on the Land Register under this Act;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of the Court and includes a Deputy
Registrar;
“surveyor” means any surveyor or other person for the time being
authorised by Cabinet to act as such for the purposes of this Act.

Land Act 1969 1011

3 The Land Register

PART 1
REGISTRATION
(1) There shall be kept in the Land Registry a book of record called “the Land Register and the Registrar shall, under this Part, enter in respect of each separate section of land in Niue (whether Crown land or Niuean land) the name, area and a plan certified by the Register under section 47 (3).
(2) The Registrar shall enter in that part of the Land Register relating to any section of land, the substance of every Court order or other instrument relating to the land of which registration is by this or any other enactment required or permitted, and which is duly presented to the Registrar for registration.
(3) [Repealed by 2004/269]

4 Compulsory registration of instruments

(1) Every instrument affecting or relating to the title to any land shall be
registered:
Provided that it shall not be necessary to register –
(a) Any lease or occupation order for a period not exceeding 2 years;
(b) Any transfer, security charge or other instrument disposing of any
lease, being a lease for a period not exceeding 2 years;
(c) Any will;
(d) Any appointment of a special representative.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) no instrument of alienation affecting
Niuean land shall be registered until the alienation referred to in such instrument
has been confirmed by the Court.

5 Effect of registration

(1) No instrument, dealing or other matter which is by this Act or any
other enactment required to be registered or entered in the Land Register shall
until it has been registered or entered be effectual to create or extinguish or transfer
or charge any interest in land.
(2) The Land Register shall in no way constitute conclusive evidence of
ownership or of title.

6 Language of instruments

Every instrument affecting Niue land shall be in the English language and
shall be accompanied by a translation into the Niuean language to the satisfaction
of the Registrar.

7 Instruments to be signed and attested

(1) (a) The execution by every person of an instrument required to be
registered under this Act shall be attested by a person authorised
to take statutory declarations under section 720 of the Niue Act
1966.
(b) No person shall attest the signature of any part to any instrument
in or by virtue of which such person acquires or disposes of any
interest.
(2) The attesting witness shall add to his signature his place of abode and
calling, office, or description and shall certify in such attestation that the instrument
has been explained by him to the party whose signature is attested and that such
party appeared to understand its contents.
1012 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) (a) The date of the execution shall be stated in the instrument and no person shall sign the instrument as an attesting witness unless the date of execution has been so stated in the instrument.
(b) Where the instrument is executed on different dates by several parties, the date of execution by each party shall be stated in the instrument.

8 Registrar may be required to give his reasons in writing

Should the Registrar refuse to register any instrument, then the person
seeking the registration of it may, in writing, require the Registrar to give, in writing
his reasons for refusing to register such instrument and the Registrar shall give
his reasons accordingly.

9 Court may make order to restore effect of lost instruments

(1) On proof to the satisfaction of the Court that any instrument has been
lost or destroyed before the same has been registered under this Act, it may make
an order under this section if it is satisfied –
(a) That the said instrument was duly executed by or on behalf of the
parties to it; and
(b) In the case of an instrument requiring confirmation, that it was duly
confirmed, or if it was not so confirmed, that the Court had made a
pronouncement in favour of confirmation; and
(c) That the instrument was not wilfully destroyed by or with the
connivance of the applicant for an order under this section.
(2) By an order under this section the Court may declare the nature and
effect of the instrument to which the order relates, and the instrument shall be
deemed to have been of the nature and to have had effect under its tenor, as declared
in this order.
(3) Instead of or in addition to making an order declaring the nature and
effect of the instrument, the Court may, on application under this section make an
order vesting any land or interest in land to which the instrument related in any
person or persons claiming under the instrument or in any other person or persons
claiming under or through the first-mentioned person or persons.
(4) On any application under this section the Court shall be guided in all
matters by what it deems to be the real justice of the case.

10 Determination of title

PART 2
INVESTIGATION OF TITLE
(1) The Court shall determine every title to and every interest in Niuean land according to the customs and usages of the Niuean people, as far as the same can be ascertained.
(2) The Court may refuse to proceed with any application for investigation of title for the determination of the Mangafaoa or relative interests in that land, until it has before it a plan of the survey of the land affected by it.
(3) The Court may at any stage of the proceedings require that all claims relating to such land, whether by the applicant or by any other person, shall be made in writing to the Court within a time to be fixed by the Court, after which time no further claims for inclusion will be admitted, except by the leave of the Court and upon such terms as the Court determines.

Land Act 1969 1013

11 Court may require written statement

The Court may require any person having an interest in any application
under this Part to lodge with the Court a statement in writing setting out any one
or more particulars of the following matters –
(a) The boundaries of the portion of the land which he claims;
(b) The grounds of the claim;
(c) The genealogical tables showing descent from the ancestor or
ancestors through whom title is claimed down to and including all
persons admitted by the claimant as entitled with him under his
claim;
(d) The names and the approximate location of cultivations, villages,
burial places, with the names of relatives of the claimant and persons
included in his claim who have been buried there, and any other
places or marks of historical interest;
(e) Any other proof or signs of occupation of or connection with the
land by the claimant and other persons included in his claim.

Ownership

12 Ownership determined by ascertaining and declaring Mangafaoa

The Court shall determine the ownership of any land by ascertaining and
declaring the Mangafaoa of that land by reference to the common ancestor of it or
by any other means which clearly identifies the Mangafaoa.

13 Relative interests

(1) (a) At any time after the ownership of land has been determined the
Court upon application, may ascertain or declare the several
members of the Mangafaoa and their relative interests in the land.
(b) The jurisdiction of the Court under this section shall not be exercised
except for the purposes of allocating moneys derived from land or
any other purposes relating to this Act.
(2) Relative interests shall, in all cases where it can be conveniently done,
be expressed in shares or decimal points of a share.

Leveki Mangafaoa

14 Appointment of Leveki Mangafaoa

(1) When the ownership of any land has been determined any member of
that Mangafaoa who was reached the age of 21 years may apply in writing to the
Court for an order appointing a Leveki Mangafaoa of that land.
(2) If the application is signed by members who in the Court’s opinion
constitute a majority of the members of the Mangafaoa whether resident in Niue
or elsewhere the Court shall issue an order appointing the person named in the
application as the Leveki Mangafaoa of that land.
(3) If no such application is received within a reasonable time, or
applications are each signed by members who, though having attained the age of
21 years, constitute less than a majority of the Mangafaoa who have attained such
age the Court may appoint a suitable person to be Leveki Mangafaoa of that land.
(4) The appointment of a Leveki Mangafaoa shall not be questioned on
the grounds that any member of the Mangafaoa was absent from Niue, but the
Court may consider any representation made in writing by any member so absent.
(5) Any person who is domiciled in Niue, and whom the Court is satisfied
is reasonably familiar with the genealogy of the family and the history and locations
of Mangafaoa land, may be appointed as a Leveki Mangafaoa of any land, but if
1014 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
he is not a member of the Mangafaoa he shall not by virtue of such appointment acquire any beneficial rights in the land.
(6) In appointing any Leveki Mangafaoa the Court may expressly limit his powers in such manner as it sees fit.

15 Powers and functions of Leveki Mangafaoa

(1) The Leveki Mangafaoa of any land, subject to this section and to the
terms of his appointment and to any order or direction of the Court, shall have
power to control the occupation and use of the land under Niuean custom and
shall have power to alienate the land in accordance with the subject to Part 3.
(2) In the exercise of his powers under this section the Leveki Mangafaoa
shall under Niuean custom consult with the members of the Mangafaoa whether
resident in Niue or elsewhere and shall in particular meet the requirements as to
consultation laid down by section 17(3) in relation to the sale and lease of land
and the giving of security charges over land.

16 Removal and replacement of Leveki Mangafaoa

(1) The Court may remove from office any Leveki Mangafaoa if in its
opinion he cannot by reason of mental or physical disability or for any reason
carry out his duties satisfactorily or if he is shown to the satisfaction of the Court
to have exercised his powers otherwise than in accordance with Niuean custom
or in accordance with equity and good conscience or if he tenders his resignation
in writing to the Registrar.
(2) Upon the death or removal from office of any Leveki Mangafaoa a new
Leveki Mangafaoa may be appointed in the manner provided by section 14 and
all the provisions of that section so far as they are applicable shall apply accordingly.
PART 3
ALIENATION OF NIUEAN LAND

General Provisions

17 Alienation of Niuean land

(1) No Niuean land or any interest of the Mangafaoa in it may be alienated
except in accordance with and subject to this section.
(2) (a) For the purposes of this section and of this Part a contract of sale of
timber, minerals, crops, or other valuable things attached to or
forming part of any Niuean land, or being the produce of it, shall
be deemed to be an alienation of that land, unless the thing so sold
or agreed to be sold has been severed from the land before the
making of the contract.
(b) The term “crops” as used in this subsection shall not extend to any
crop which attains maturity and may be harvested within the period
of 2 years from sowing or planting.
(3) Subject to section 22 as to the confirmation by the Court, Niuean land
may be alienated by the Leveki Mangafaoa in any of the following ways –
(a) He may transfer the land to the Crown under and subject to section
43;
(b) He may lease the land under and subject to sections 26 and 29;
(c) He may give a security charge over the land under and subject to
sections 26 and 32.

Land Act 1969 1015

(4) Nothing in this section shall be construed to affect the operation of any of the following provisions –
(a) Section 30 relating to the execution by the Registrar, in certain cases, of renewals of leases;
(b) Section 31 relating to the making by the Court of occupation orders; (c) Section 33 relating to the making of an order for the appointment
of a receiver;
(d) Sections 34 to 39 relating to the making of partition orders;
(e) Sections 40 to 42 relating to the making by the Court of exchange
orders;
(f) Sections 44 to 46 relating to the making by the Court of an order
setting apart any Niuean land as a reservation for communal
purposes;
(g) Section 51 relating to the taking of land by the Crown for public
purposes;
(h) Section 14 and 15 of the Electric Power Supply Act 1960 relating to
the taking of land by the Crown for public purposes;
(i) Sections 47 and 89 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 relating
to the making by the Court of orders creating easements or rights
of way over Niuean land;
(j) Part 4 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 relating to the making
by the Court of orders vesting Niuean land in bodies corporate for
church purposes;
(k) Part 7 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 relating to the
declaration of any Niuean land as a road;
(l) Part 16 of the Niue Act 1966 relating to the declaration by the Court
of Niuean land to be subject to such land development provisions
and the constitution of charges in respect of it;
(m) The Mining Act 1977 in so far as it relates to the issue, grant,
suspension, revocation or surrender of any licence affecting or
relating to Niuean land.

18 Interest in Niuean land not to be taken in execution

(1) No interest of any person in Niuean land shall be capable of being taken
in execution or otherwise rendered available by any form of judicial process for
the payment of his debts or liabilities, whether in favour of the Crown or in favour
of any other person.
(2) Nothing in this section shall affect the operation of any security charge
or other charge to which the land is or may be subject.

19 Restrictions on disposition of proceeds of Niuean land

(1) An assignment of any rent, purchase money, cropping proceeds or other
money which is or may become receivable in respect of Niuean land or any interest
of the Mangafaoa in it may be given in the approved form by the Leveki Mangafaoa,
or (in respect of his personal interest) by a member of the Mangafaoa or by any
lessee or licensee, to any of the following –
(a) The Crown;
(b) [Repealed 5/94/1984]
(c) Any lending institution approved by Cabinet.
(2) Except as provided in by subsection (1) no assignment, charge or other
disposition shall be given over the proceeds of any rent, purchase money, or other
money which is or may become receivable in respect of Niuean land or any interest
in it.
1016 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

20 Purchase money, rents or other proceeds of alienation

(1) All proceeds from any alienation, whether by way of purchase money,
rent, or otherwise shall be paid to the Registrar for distribution to the Leveki
Mangafaoa or the persons entitled to it.
(2) The receipt of the Registrar shall be a sufficient discharge for any money
so paid in the same manner as if the money had been paid to the persons entitled
to it.
(3) All money so paid into the Court shall after any necessary deduction be paid out of Court to the Leveki Mangafaoa or the persons entitled to it as determined by any order of the Court.

21 Registrar may charge commission

(1) The Registrar shall be entitled to charge a commission at the rate of 5
per cent on the money paid into the Court under section 20.
(2) The Court, having regard to the amount of money paid, to the number
of persons entitled to it, and any other relevant matters, may direct that a lower
rate of commission be charged in any specified case.

Confirmation

22 Alienation to be confirmed

(1) No alienation of Niuean land by the Leveki Mangafaoa shall have any
force or effect unless and until it has been confirmed by the Court.
(2) An appeal shall lie to the Court of Appeal from any decision of the
Court to grant or refuse confirmation of an alienation or from any variation by the
Court of the terms of any alienation.
(3) Nothing in this section shall apply to any arrangement or decision of
the Leveki Mangafaoa by which any person is given the right to use any land for
a period not exceeding 2 years.

23 Application for confirmation

No confirmation of an alienation of Niuean land by the Leveki Mangafaoa
shall be granted, unless an application for it is made by or on behalf of a party to
the instrument of alienation within 6 months after the date of the execution of the
instrument by the Leveki Mangafaoa.

24 Orders of a confirmation

Confirmation shall be granted by an order of the Court and a certificate of
such confirmation shall be endorsed or otherwise written on the instrument of
alienation signed by a Judge of the Court, or by the Registrar acting under the
authority of a Judge and sealed with the seal of the Court.

25 Effect of confirmation

Subject to Part 1 as to registration on confirmation being granted, the
instrument of alienation shall (if otherwise valid) take effect under its tenor as
from and including the date at which it would have taken effect if no such
confirmation had been required.

26 Conditions of confirmation

(1) Subject to this section, no alienation shall be confirmed unless the Court
is satisfied as to the following matters –
(a) That the instrument of alienation has been executed in the manner
required by this Act;

Land Act 1969 1017

(b) That the alienation is not contrary to equity or good faith, or to the interests of the persons alienating or to the public interest;
(c) That having regard to the relationship (if any) of the parties and to any other special circumstances of the case the rental or consideration (if any) for the alienation is adequate;
(d) That any lease which exceeds 5 years duration and any security
charge has been agreed to by the majority of the members of the
Mangafaoa whether resident in Niue or elsewhere;
(e) That the alienation is not otherwise prohibited by law.
(2) The Court may confirm an alienation notwithstanding any informality
or irregularity in the mode of execution of the instrument of alienation if, having
regard to the interest of all the parties, it is satisfied that the informality or
irregularity is immaterial.
(3) No confirmation of an alienation shall be questioned or invalidated on
the ground of any error or irregularity in the procedure by which it was applied
for or granted.

27 Confirmation of instruments in pursuance of precedent contract

When any valid contract to grant or renew a lease, or any other valid contract
of alienation, has been duly confirmed, the confirmation of any lease or other
instrument of alienation under that contract shall, if the instrument is duly executed
under this Act, be granted by the Court as a matter of right.

28 Alteration of instruments on confirmation

(1) On an application for confirmation, the Court may, with the consent of
all parties to the instrument of alienation, make, under the seal of the Court, such
alterations as may be thought necessary in order to justify confirmation, and may
thereupon confirm the alienation.
(2) The instrument of alienation as so altered shall, if otherwise valid, take
effect as if the alterations had been made before its execution.

Leases

29 Leases of Niuean land not to exceed 60 years

(1) Except as provided in this section no lease of Niuean land shall be for a
longer period than 60 years (including any term or terms of renewal to which the
lessee may be entitled).
(2) Every such lease shall be granted so as to take effect in possession within
one year from and including the date of the first execution of it by any party to it.
(3) With the prior written approval of Cabinet, leases may be granted for
afforestation purposes or for the purpose of erecting commercial or industrial
buildings providing for a renewal period taking the total term beyond 60 years if
the right to such period or periods is expressed to be conditional upon the
performance during the earlier term or terms of certain specified covenants as to
the planting and care of trees, or to the erection in permanent materials of
substantial improvements.
(4) A lease may be granted for public purposes or church purposes for a
period not exceeding 60 years with perpetual rights of renewal or with other rights
of renewal taking the total period beyond 60 years. Every such lease shall be
expressed to be for public purposes or church purposes and shall provide for the
termination of the lease if the land ceases to be used exclusively for those purposes.
(5) No lease of Niuean land shall make provision for the payment to the
lessee of compensation for improvements effected by him on or to the land.
1018 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(6) Every lease made under this section shall be in an approved form.
(7) Nothing in this section shall be construed to apply to any lease of Niuean
land to the Crown.

30 Registrar may execute renewals

(1) The lessee under any lease of Niuean land (whether granted before or
after the commencement of this Act) who claims that he is entitled to a renewal of
his lease and that it is difficult or impossible to obtain execution by the Leveki
Mangafaoa of an instrument of renewal may apply to the Court for an order
directing the Registrar to execute, as an agent of the Mangafaoa, an instrument of
renewal in accordance with the terms of the lease, and the Court may make such
order accordingly.
(2) On the making of an order under this section, the Registrar shall have
full authority in accordance with the terms of the order to execute the renewal of
the lease as if he were the duly appointed agent of the Mangafaoa.

Occupation Orders

31 Court may make occupation orders

(1) The Court may under this section make in respect of any Niuean land
to a member of the Mangafaoa or the spouse or surviving spouse of a Member or
a Member and spouse jointly an occupation order on such terms and conditions
not inconsistent with this section as may be specified in the order.
(2) Application for an occupation order shall be made by the Leveki
Mangafaoa or by the member of the Mangafaoa desiring the order, or by both,
and shall be accompanied by a description and plan of the area to be occupied.
(3) Every occupation order shall upon registration take effect under its
tenor.
(4) Unless the area concerned has already been defined by survey and used
or occupied as a separate section an occupation order shall not be made over an area of less than 20 perches in the case of a village site and less than 2 acres for a plantation area.
(5) An occupation order may be made for the personal use of the person
for whose favour it is made for his lifetime or for some specified term of years or
may be granted upon terms that it passes to that person’s successors under Niuean
custom.
(6) Every occupation order of village site land shall, if possible, be made in
favour of a husband and wife jointly.
(7) No rental or premium shall be payable in respect of an occupation order.
(8) Such occupation order may provide for the termination of it and the
reversion to the Mangafaoa of the land affected if the person in whose favour it is
made or the person otherwise entitled to the benefit of it;
(a) Ceases to make full use of the land for any period of not less than 2
years which may be specified in such occupation order;
(b) Is absent from Niue for any period of not less than 2 years which
may be specified in such occupation order otherwise than with the
prior written approval of Cabinet for the purpose of any training,
education or instruction;
(c) Fails to perform any of the special covenants which may be specified
in the order;
(d) Surrenders rights conferred by the order by executing an instrument
in the approved form.

Land Act 1969 1019

(9) (a) The Leveki Mangafaoa or the Registrar may apply to the Court for a certificate that the order has for any reason specified in subsection (8) terminated and the Court may, if it is satisfied that the order was terminated under subsection (8), give a certificate accordingly.
(b) Any such certificate may be registered.

Security Charges

32 Security charge over Niuean land

(1) Security over Niuean land or any interest of the Mangafaoa in any land
and security over the interest of any nature of any person in Niuean land may be
given by means of a security charge created under this section or any other charge
created by or under any enactment.
(2) No security over Niuean land or any interests in it as aforesaid shall be
given to any person or body except to –
(a) The Crown;
(b) [Repealed 5/94/1984]
(c) Any lending institution approved for the purposes of this section
by Cabinet.
(3) Security over Niuean land or any interest in it of the Mangafaoa, or
over the interest of any nature of any person in Niuean land shall be created by an
instrument in an approved form executed by the Leveki Mangafaoa or by the
other person giving the security and registered under Part 1:
Provided however that any security charge executed by a Leveki Mangafaoa
shall be subject to confirmation by the Court as provided by sections 22 to 28.
(4) Except as provided in this section no security shall be given or
constituted over Niuean land or any interest in it.
(5) No charge or security charge over Niuean land or any interest shall be
enforceable by sale of the land or interest charged.

33 Appointment of Receiver

The Court, on application and proof of default, may enforce a charge or
security charge as aforesaid by appointing in respect of the land or interest charged
a receiver and section 56 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 shall apply as if
the receiver had been appointed under that section.

Partitions

34 Jurisdiction to partition Niuean land

(1) The Court shall have exclusive jurisdiction to partition Niuean land.
(2) The jurisdiction to partition shall be discretionary and the Court may
refuse to exercise it in any case in which it is of the opinion that partition would be
inexpedient in the public interest or in the interests of the Mangafaoa or other
persons interested in the land.

35 Court may apportion rights and obligations

(1) When a partition order is made, the Court may, in that order or in any
subsequent order made on the application of any person interested, or of the
Registrar, or of its own motion, apportion or adjust as between the several pieces
into which the land has been partitioned all rights, obligations, or liabilities arising
from any lease, occupation order, or charge to which the land is subject at the date
of the partition of it and every such order of apportionment or adjustment shall
have effect according to its tenor in the same manner in all respects as if all necessary
transfers, releases, covenants, and other dispositions or agreements had been duly
made in that behalf by all persons concerned.
1020 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) In the exercise of its powers under this section the Court shall not make any apportionment or adjustment without the consent of each and every –
(a) Lessee of the land; and
(b) Person having an interest in the land, by virtue of an order made
under section 31, where the order has been made upon the terms
mentioned in that section; and
(c) Person or body in whose favour a security charge created under
section 32, subsists over the land or over any interest in the land.
(3) Subject to subsection (2) the Court may exercise the powers of
apportionment or adjustment, conferred upon it by subsection (1).

36 Discretionary powers of Court

In partitioning any land the Court may exercise the following discretionary
powers –
(a) It may where the Leveki Mangafaoa wishes to allocate a portion of the land to a member of the Mangafaoa or the Mangafaoa has become unduly large or in cases of irreconcilable family disputes, partition the land among groups of members of the Mangafaoa on what appears to the Court to be the general desire of the persons concerned to be just and equitable;
(b) It shall avoid, as far as practicable, the subdivision of any land into
areas which because of their smallness or their configuration or for
any other reason, are unsuitable for separate ownership or
occupation;
(c) It may appoint new Leveki Mangafaoa in respect of the pieces of
land affected by any partition orders.

37 Combination of several areas of land

When the Mangafaoa of one area of land is also the Mangafaoa of any other
areas of land, the Court may, for the purposes of partition between groups of
members of the Mangafaoa, treat those several areas as a single area owned by
them and make an order or orders of partition accordingly.

38 Saving of interests charged on partitioned land

If, on the partition of any land, the share or interest of any person is subject
to any right, charge, or interest vested in any other person, that right, charge, or
interest shall, subject to any apportionment or adjustment made under section 35
attach to and affect the land or interest that is allocated by the partition order to
the owners of the first-mentioned share or interest.

39 Entries in Land Register

When any land is partitioned by the Court, the Registrar shall give effect to
the partition by entries in the land Register, recording particulars of any new section
thereby created and to the extent necessary for cancelling or amending any former
entry.

Exchanges

40 Court may make exchange orders

(1) The Court may make an order of exchange of Niuean land.
(2) Any interest in Niuean land may be exchanged for an interest in any
other Niuean land or in Crown land.

Land Act 1969 1021

41 Conditions of exchange

The Court shall not make an order of exchange unless satisfied –
(a) That the exchange is not detrimental to the interests of the
Mangafaoa affected by it;
(b) (i) That the interests to be so exchanged are in the opinion of the
Court approximately equal in value; or
(ii) That where in the opinion of the Court the interests so
exchanged are so unequal in value as to require this course, a
sufficient sum of money by way of equality of exchange has
been actually paid, or sufficient security for the payment of it
has been given;
(c) That the majority (or where there are less than 5 members, the whole
of the members of the Mangafaoa) of the members of the Mangafaoa
whether resident in Niue or elsewhere consent to the exchange;
(d) That the Minister consents to the exchange of any Crown land.

42 Effect of order of exchange

(1) An order of exchange shall operate under its tenor to transfer and vest
the respective interests expressed to be exchanged in the same manner as if all
necessary instruments of assurance had been lawfully executed by and between
all persons interested, and as if they had all been fully competent in that behalf.
(2) When any Crown land becomes vested in a Mangafaoa by an order of
exchange, the land shall become Niuean land.

Sales

43 Sale of Niuean land to the Crown

(1) Niuean land may be alienated to the Crown by way of transfer by an
instrument of transfer executed by the Leveki Mangafaoa and confirmed by the
Court.
(2) The instrument of transfer shall not be confirmed by the Court until the members of the Mangafaoa and their shares have been ascertained by the Court.
(3) On application of the Crown or the Leveki Mangafaoa the Court shall be satisfied that the majority (or where there are less than 5 members, the whole of the members of the Mangafaoa) of the members of the Mangafaoa whether resident in Niue or elsewhere consent to the terms and conditions of the sale.
(4) If some members of the Mangafaoa of the land object to the sale of land to the Crown, the Court may make a partition order setting apart the shares of the members objecting if it is satisfied that the land can be economically subdivided. (5) Any members of the Mangafaoa of the land affected by the sale who
are absent from Niue may forward their consents or objections in writing to the
Registrar or appoint in writing some person to appear and speak on their behalf
in the Court.
(6) In the registration of an instrument of alienation of Niuean land to the
Crown duly confirmed by the Court, the land shall become Crown land.

Reservations

44 Reservations for communal purposes

(1) The Court may on the application of any Leveki Mangafaoa and with
the consent of the majority of the members, who in the Court’s opinion constitute
a majority of the members of the Mangafaoa who are ordinarily resident in Niue,
make an order setting apart any Niuean land, which is not subject to any charge,
1022 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
as a reservation for the common use of the residents of a village, or of a Church or other group or institution for such purpose as a burial ground, fishing ground, village site, landing place, place of historic interest, source of water supply, Church site, building site, recreation ground, bathing place or any other specified purpose whatsoever.
(2) Before making such an order the Court shall be satisfied that the
members of the Mangafaoa who are not ordinarily resident in Niue will not as a
result of the proposed order suffer undue hardship.

45 Revocation or variation of reservation

(1) A reservation order may be revoked or varied by the Court whether as
to boundaries of the land included in the reservation or as to the purposes of it.
(2) Where by reason of the revocation or variation of any reservation order
under this section any land ceases to be a reservation or part of a reservation the
land shall vest, as of its former estate in the Mangafaoa and in which it was vested
immediately before it was constituted or as included in the reservation, or in their
successors. In any such case the Court may make an order vesting the land in the
Mangafaoa found by it to be entitled to the land, and if necessary ascertaining the
members of the Mangafaoa and their relative interests.

46 Management and control of reservations

The Court may by order, vest any reservation in any body corporate or in
one or more persons in trust to hold and administer it for the benefit of the persons
or class of persons for whose benefit the reservation is constituted, and may appoint
a new trustee or new trustees or additional trustees.
PART 4
SURVEYS

47 Control and supervision of surveys

(1) The control and supervision of all surveys of land in Niue, and the
preparation of plans in relation thereto shall be the responsibility of the Registrar.
(2) No survey of land shall be conducted except under an order of the
Court or by the Registrar or with his prior written authority and all such survey
shall be carried out by a surveyor.
(3) Any plan or diagram required to be endorsed on or appended to any
instrument or otherwise included in the Land Register shall be prepared by or
with the authority of the Registrar and shall be certified by him as representing
the true boundaries of the land and such other details as may be relevant as agreed
to by the interested parties or as determined by the Court.
(4) No charge shall be made for any survey for the purpose of the initial
registration of any section of land or for the preparation of plans in relation thereto.
(5) Fees may be charged for any survey or for the preparation of any plan
or diagram otherwise than provided in subsection (4) at such rate as may be fixed
by the Registrar.

48 Authority for survey

(1) The Registrar or any person authorised in writing by the Court or by
the Registrar may during the hours of daylight enter upon any land for the purpose
of carrying out a survey of the land or any part of it and may do all things
reasonably necessary for the purposes of such survey.
(2) The Leveki Mangafaoa or the occupier of any land claiming to have
suffered damage under subsection (1) by the entry on it for the purposes of survey
may lodge a claim for compensation for such damage with the Registrar.

Land Act 1969 1023

(3) The Registrar may make good any damage caused as aforesaid or may authorise payment in settlement of the claim.
(4) Any applicant not satisfied with the decision of the Registrar on his claim may apply to the Court to determine the amount (if any) of compensation and the Court shall issue an order accordingly.

49 Authority to enter on land

Before entry is made on any land under section 48 for the purposes of survey
the Registrar shall give or cause to be given to the Leveki Mangafaoa or to any
occupier of the land such notice as is reasonable in the circumstances.

50 Obstruction

(1) Any person wilfully preventing or obstructing any survey, authorised
under this Act or any other enactment, or destroying, effacing or removing any
survey pegs or boundary mark placed under the authority of this Act shall be
liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and shall also be
liable to make good any loss or damage thereby occasioned.
(2) Any person having knowledge of the removal, destruction or possibility
of the removal or destruction of any boundary mark or survey monument shall
inform the Registrar who shall take such steps as are necessary and expedient to
protect, repair or replace the same.
PART 5
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

51 Procedure for taking land for public purposes

(1) Cabinet may direct the Registrar to give notice under this section of a
proposal to take land for public purposes.
(2) (a) The Registrar shall prepare a plan of the area proposed to be taken
on which shall be set forth the names of the Mangafaoa involved
and as far as possible the names and addresses of the Leveki
Mangafaoa and of any lessee or occupier of the particular areas.
(b) The plan shall be held in the office of the Court and shall be available
for public inspection.
(3) (a) The Registrar shall give notice in writing of the proposed taking of
land to the Leveki Mangafaoa and to any lessee or other person
possessing an interest likely to suffer injury by the taking including
any person or body in whose favour a security charge over the land
exists.
(b) Each such notice shall advise that the plan may be inspected at the
office of the Land Court and that any person may give to the
Registrar within 30 days of the date of the notice written notification
of his objection to the proposal and his reasons for it.
(4) The Registrar shall, where an objection has been lodged fix a time and
place at which the objector may appear before Cabinet and support the objection
by evidence and argument and shall give to the objector notice in writing of such
time and place.
(5) If within the said period of 30 days no written notice of objection is
received by the Registrar, or if after due consideration of the objection or objections
Cabinet is of the opinion that effect should be given to the proposal to take the
land for the public purpose, and that no private injury will be done by it for which
due compensation is not provided by any enactment Cabinet may recommend to
the Minister that the land be taken for the public purpose under section 11 of the
Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968.
1024 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(6) In any case where the ownership of the land proposed to be taken has not been determined or a Leveki Mangafaoa has not been appointed or it is considered desirable to determine the members of the Mangafaoa and their relative interests, the Registrar may apply to the Court to exercise its jurisdiction accordingly.
(7) In any case where under any enactment or otherwise authority exists
for the Crown through its servants, agents or workmen to enter on any Niuean
land to carry out works for any public purpose, and no express provision is made
as to the giving of notice, Cabinet or some person authorised by it shall before any
entry is made on the land give to the Leveki Mangafaoa or to any occupier of the
land, such notice of his intention to enter as is reasonable in the circumstances.

52 Registrar’s powers

(1) The Registrar may in the exercise of his powers under this Act state
any case or reserve any question for consideration by the Court, or apply for
directions to the Court, and the Court shall have the power to hear and determine
the case or question, or give directions accordingly.
(2) Any person aggrieved by a decision of the Registrar given in pursuance
of his powers under this Act may appeal to the Court, which may confirm, quash
or vary the decision but no appeal shall lie under this subsection in any case where
the decision of the Registrar has been given in confirmity with the determination
by the Court of a case or question stated or reserved by him in connection with
the same matter for its consideration under subsection (1).
(3) The Registrar may, for the purposes of this Act –
(a) In writing, require any person to produce any or give any
information relating to land or to any interest in land;
(b) In connection with any dealing with any land or interest in it, or
with any disposition of it, in writing require any person having the
custody or control of any duplicate instrument concerned to bring
it into the Land Registry to be endorsed, cancelled, amended,
inspected or otherwise dealt with as the case requires;
(c) Make or delete all such entries upon or from the land register,
instrument, duplicate, map, plan or other document as are necessary
by reason of the operation of this Act or any other enactment.

53 Officers not personally liable

Neither the Registrar nor any members of his staff shall be personally liable
to any action or proceeding for or in respect of any act or matter bona fide done,
or omitted to be done by him or them in the exercise or supposed exercise of the
powers conferred upon them by this Act or any other enactment.

54 [Spent]

1025

LIQUOR ACT 1975

1975/2 – 13 February 1975

1

Short title

12

Offence to drink liquor in public

2

Interpretation

thoroughfares

3

Liquor Board

13

Prohibition orders

4

Manufacture and importation of liquor

14

Penalties

5

Minister may import liquor

15

Commencement of proceedings

6

[Spent]

16

Powers of constables

7

Sales of liquor by Government

17

Regulations

8

Licences to resell liquor

18

[Spent]

9

Offences by licensees

10

Offence to sell liquor without authority

SCHEDULE

11

Offences by persons under 18 years

To provide for the control of the manufacture and sale of liquor in Niue

1 Short title

This is the Liquor Act 1975.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“Board” means the Liquor Board;
“Secretary” means the Financial Secretary;
“Commissioner” means a Commissioner of the High Court;
“Director” means the Director of Health;
“liquor” means any spirit, wine, ale, beer, stout, cider or any other fermented
distilled or spirituous liquor ordinarily used as a beverage which
contains more than 2 parts per cent of proof spirit;
“Minister” means the Minister of Customs, Shipping and Trade;
“police officer” means any constable of any rank acting with the express
authority and under the instructions of the Chief Officer of Police.
(2) Where by this Act the Minister is enabled to delegate any of his powers
to the Secretary, or to authorise the Secretary to take any action, he may in addition
to it or in lieu of it delegate to or authorise any other officer of the Customs
Department.
(3) Nothing in this Act shall apply to a minister of religion obtaining and
using or giving wine or other liquor in connection with any religious rite or
sacrament.

3 Liquor Board

(1) There is hereby established for the purposes of this Act, a Board to be
known as the Liquor Board which shall consist of not less than 3 persons nor more
than 6 persons to be appointed by Cabinet.
1026

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(2) The persons appointed by the Cabinet from the general public shall hold office for a term of 3 years from the date of their appointment and may in like manner be reappointed.
(3) Three members of the Board present at a meeting shall form a quorum. (4) The Board shall have power to –
(a) Grant or refuse any application for a licence under this Act:
Provided that no such application shall be finally considered by
the Board until a written report from the Chief of Police has been
received and considered by the Board;
(b) Hold such inquiries and advise the Government on matters relating
to the control of manufacture, sale and consumption of liquor in
Niue;
(c) Prescribe fees to be paid for licences under this Act;
(d) Fix the price payable to licensees for liquor sold by them;
(e) Prescribe opening and closing hours for the sale of liquor by
licensees;
(f) To do such things as may be prescribed by regulations under this
Act.
(5) There shall be a Secretary of the Board who shall be appointed by the
Public Service Commission and who may hold any other office in the Public Service
which the Public Service Commission shall consider to be not incompatible with
it.
(6) Members of the Board not being members of the Public Service may be paid in respect of each day or part of a day of attendance as members of the Board such sum as Cabinet shall determine, together with any expenses reasonably incurred by them in respect of their attendances at meetings of the Board.

4 Manufacture and importation of liquor

(1) It shall not be lawful for any person to brew or manufacture liquor in
Niue except with the prior written authority of the Board to be given on such terms and conditions as it may deem fit to impose and to be consistent with any regulations made under this Act.
(2) Except as provided in section 5 it shall not be lawful for any person to import any liquor into Niue:
Provided that it shall be lawful for any person of or over the age of 18 years
returning or entering into Niue to bring with him as part of his personal baggage
and exempt from customs duty an amount that does not exceed:
(a) (i) 3.5 litres of spirits; or
(ii) 3.5 litres of liquor; or
(iii) 3.5 litres of wine; or
(iv) any combination of (i)-(iii) above provided that the total volume
does not exceed 3.5 litres; or
(b) 8.5 litres of beer.
(3) Every person who carries, conveys or conceals any liquor brewed,
manufactured or imported in breach of this section or, who has in his possession
or control any such liquor, or who is the owner, lessee, or occupier of any premises
in or about which any such liquor is found, shall be guilty of an offence, unless in
the case of an accused charged with being the owner, lessee, or occupier of premises
in which any such liquor is found as aforesaid he satisfies the Court that such
liquor was not there with his knowledge or consent.

Liquor Act 1975 1027

5 Minister may import liquor

(1) The Minister may, for and on behalf of the Government, and at the cost
of the Treasury Operating Account purchase and import into Niue such liquor of
such nature as he thinks fit for sale or use under this Act.
(2) The Minister may delegate all or any of his powers under subsection
(1) to the Secretary.
(3) The Board may grant a licence to a person to import liquor.
(4) A licence granted under subsection (3) is valid for one year but may be
terminated by the Board if the licensee is convicted of an offence under this Act.

6 [Spent]

7 Sales of liquor by Government

(1) The Government may sell liquor to any persons of or over the age of 18
years who have not been prohibited under a prohibition order, at such prices as
the Minister shall fix.
(2) Such sales shall be made for cash and from such Government store on
such days and between such hours as the Minister shall direct.
(3) No such sale shall be of less liquor than is contained in a bottle or can
or other sealed container, and no liquor shall be consumed by any person at any
such store.
(4) The Secretary shall keep proper records relating to the importation
custody and sale or other disposition of liquor.

8 Licences to resell liquor

(1) (a) It shall be lawful for the Board to grant, on application in the manner
set out in the Schedule and upon payment of the appropriate fee a
licence to the owners or occupiers of suitable premises authorising
the holder of it to sell liquor in the licensed premises at such times
and during such hours as shall be stipulated in the licence.
(b) No licence shall be granted under this section without due regard
being had to the general policy in relation to it of the Village Council
of the village wherein such premises are situated.
(2) A licence issued under this section shall be renewed annually on March
31 and shall be subject to all such terms and conditions imposed in each case as
the Board thinks fit and the Board may cancel or vary any such licence.
(3) Any such licence may, at the Board’s discretion, authorise the sale of
liquor for consumption on the premises only or for consumption off the premises
only, or for consumption either on the premises or off the premises.

9 Offences by licensees

(1) Every licensee who shall sell or expose for sale any liquor at any place
or time or in any quantity or manner not authorised by his licence or by this Act
shall be guilty of an offence.
(2) Any licensee who sells or supplies or allows to be sold or supplied any
liquor to any person under 18 years of age shall be guilty of an offence.
(3) Every licensee commits an offence, who –
(a) Permits drunkenness, violence, quarrelsome behaviour, or
disorderly or riotous conduct to take place on his licensed premises
or sells any liquor to any drunken person; or
(b) Knowingly permits any disorderly or drunken persons to assemble
or remain on his licensed premises; or
1028 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(c) Suffers or permits his licenced premises to be used as a gaming house within the meaning of section 176 of the Niue Act 1966.
(4) Every licensee shall be responsible for the acts or omissions of his servants or agents in contravention of this Act, notwithstanding that it shall appear that the offence charged was not committed by such licensee personally but by his servant or agent.

10 Offence to sell liquor without authority

Every person not being licensed under or by virtue of this Act to sell liquor,
who sells or offers or exposes or keeps for sale any liquor commits an offence.

11 Offences by persons under 18 years

(1) Every person under the age of 18 years commits an offence, who –
(a) Purchases or consumes or has possession of any liquor on any
premises where liquor is sold; or
(b) Has possession of any liquor in any place of resort open to or used
by the public.
(2) Every person commits an offence who, not being a licensee or agent or
servant of a licensee supplies any liquor to a person under the age of 18 years in
any place of resort open to the public.

12 Offence to drink liquor in public thoroughfares

Every person commits an offence who drinks any liquor on any road, street,
footpath, alley or any thoroughfare of a public nature, or in any public passenger
carrying vehicle or on any village green other than during the course of an official
function lawfully held on it.

13 Prohibition orders

(1) Upon the application of any person or any relative of such person or of
the Police, and upon proof that such person is of confirmed intemperate habits a
Commissioner may make a prohibition order in respect of such person prohibiting
him from possessing or consuming any liquor for such period not exceeding 2
years as the Commissioner shall determine.
(2) Every prohibited person who purchases or procures or possesses or
consumes liquor during the currency of a prohibition order commits an offence.
(3) Every person commits an offence who knowingly procures any liquor
for a prohibited person or assists such person to procure liquor.
(4) A prohibition order may at any time not less than 6 months after the
date of the order be rescinded by a Commissioner on being satisfied that the
prohibited person has in all respects complied with the prohibition order and
appears unlikely to revert to his previous intemperate habits.
(5) Whenever a Commissioner has made a prohibition order under this
Act he shall cause notice of it to be given to the Chief Officer of Police, the Secretary,
and all licensees holding licences granted under section 8.

14 Penalties

(1) Any person convicted of an offence against this Act or any regulations
made under this Act shall, until and unless any other penalty is provided, be
liable for a first offence to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and for a second
or any subsequent offence to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or
a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units, or both.
(2) Where any offender against this Act is a licensee, the convicting court
may in addition recommend to the Board that his licence be cancelled.

Liquor Act 1975 1029

(3) Where a second or subsequent offence involving drunknness is committed by any person the court in addition to any other penalty may make a prohibition order against him.
(4) On the conviction of any person for an offence against this Act, the court, in addition to any other penalty imposed or order made by it, may declare any liquor which has been seized by the Police under section 16 (c) and in respect of which such person is convicted together with the container of such liquor, to be forfeited to the Government, to be sold, destroyed, or otherwise disposed of as the Minister thinks fit.

15 Commencement of proceedings

All proceedings for offences against this Act shall be commenced within a
period of 6 months after the commission of the offence charged, and may be
instituted and prosecuted in the name or at the instance of the Chief Officer of
Police or the Secretary.

16 Powers of constables

Any constable may at any time –
(a) Enter on and inspect any licenced premises or any part of it;
(b) Demand the name address and age of any person in any licensed
premises;
(c) On suspecting on reasonable grounds that an offence against this
Act has probably been committed at or in any place to enter on
such place under the authority of a search warrant to be duly
obtained by him, and to seize any liquor the possession of which is
not satisfactorily accounted for by any owner or occupant of such
place, such liquor to be held in safe custody pending an order being
made under section 14 (4) in relation to it.

17 Regulations

(1) The Minister acting on the advice of Cabinet may make all such
regulations as shall be necessary or expedient for giving full effect to this Act and
for the due administration of it.
(2) Without limiting the general power conferred by subsection (1), it is
hereby declared that regulations may be made under this section for all or any of
the following purposes –
(a) Prescribing procedures and forms in respect of applications for,
grant of and renewal of licensees:
Provided that unless and until such regulations shall be made
amending the form of application for and grant of a licence the
form contained in the Schedule shall be the form for the several
matters referred to in the Schedule;
(b) Providing for the keeping of records and accounts for the purposes
of this Act;
(c) Prescribing minimum standards with respect to the location size
and nature of premises to qualify for the issue of a licence under
this Act.

18 [Spent]


1030 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
SCHEDULE

Section 8

Application for Licence to Sell Liquor

To the Secretary, Liquor Board

Application is hereby made for a licence to sell liquor in accordance with the following particulars

1 Name of applicant ................................................................................................................

2 Occupation .............................................................................................................................

3 Address ..................................................................................................................................

4 Location of premises where licence is sought ..................................................................

5 Full description of premises (eg club, restaurant, shop, etc) ..........................................

.................................................................................................................................................

6 Size and nature of premises ................................................................................................

7 .................................................................................................................................................

8 Proposed hours of operation (eg opening and closing). Whether split (eg 2pm-5pm,

7pm -10pm, etc. ............................................................................................................................

9 Additional facilities offered to members, patrons or customers (eg coffee, light snack, meals, entertainment, games, dancing, music, toilet).

SIGNED by or on behalf of the applicant

Signature ................................................................ Date .........................................................................

FOR OFFICE USE ONLY

Application No. ....................................... Date Received ........................................................

Previous Application .............................. Granted/Refused ..................................................

Date this application presented to Board .................................................................................

This application: Granted/Refused .................................................................................

Terms on which licence granted: (e.g. hours, etc) ...................................................................

Fee payable

1031

MANUFACTURED GOODS TAX ACT 1964

1964/21 – 2 June 1964

10A New Zealand Representative Act 1981

11 [Spent]

SCHEDULE

To provide for the imposition and collection of a tax on certain goods imported into, or manufactured in Niue

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Manufactured Goods Tax Act 1964.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“current domestic value” has the same meaning as in the Customs Act
1966;
“goods” means movable personal property of all kinds;
“motor vehicle” means a vehicle which is drawn or propelled by mechanical
power, but does not include –
(a) A tractor within the meaning of the Transport Act 1965;
(b) Any bulldozer, earth-scraper, earth-removing machine, earth-
dumper, mobile crane or otherwise, or any other similar machine;
or
(c) Any agricultural implement;
“value” in relation to goods, means –
(a) For the purposes of Part 2, their current domestic value; and
(b) For the purposes of Part 3 the cost of their production as ascertained
by the Treasurer by reference to such accounting records as may be
required to be kept by manufacturers by regulations made under
this Act.
1032 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

3 Recovery of tax

(1) Tax payable under this Act (including any penalty charged under
subsection (2), shall constitute a debt due to the Government and shall be
recoverable as such at suit of the Treasurer.
(2) If default is made in the payment of any tax payable under this Act the
person making default shall be chargeable by way of penalty with additional tax
equivalent to 50 per cent of the amount of tax in respect of which default was
made.

4 Rates of tax payable

PART 2
TAX ON IMPORTED GOODS
(1) There shall be payable on all goods imported into Niue of the kind named in the Schedule a tax at the respective rates set out in it.
(2) The tax hereby imposed shall be payable on the sum of the value of
such goods and the amount of Customs duty payable on such goods.

5 Payment

Tax payable under this Part shall be paid to the Treasurer by the importer
of the goods before the entry of such goods is passed by the Revenue Manager.

6 Personal effects exempted

(1) In this section –
“motor car”, “motor cycle”, “power cycle”, “taxicab”, “tractor”, “trade
motor” and “trailer” have the meanings attributed to them respectively
by section 3(1) of the Transport Act 1965;
“personal effects” means and includes any personal effects, personal
clothing, personal baggage, household goods, domestic chattels or
private motor vehicle;
“private motor vehicle” means any motor car, motor cycle, power cycle or
trailer, but does not include any taxicab, tractor or trade motor.
(2) Subject to subsection (3), nothing in this Act shall apply to any personal
effects owned by any person at the date of that person’s arrival in Niue, and also
owned by such person at the date of the import of the personal effects in Niue,
and also imported in Niue –
(a) During the period of 3 months immediately prior to that person’s
arrival in Niue; or
(b) Upon that person’s arrival in Niue; or
(c) During the period of 3 months immediately after that person’s
arrival in Niue; and
neither sold, nor bartered, nor given way, nor otherwise disposed of by such person
during the period of one year immediately after the import of such personal effects
into Niue.
(3) Where, under subsection (2) any private motor vehicle has not been
taxed under this Act and where, during the period of 5 years immediately after
the import of such vehicle into Niue, such vehicle is used or converted for use as
a taxicab, tractor or trade motor, then tax shall, under this Act, be paid, by the
owner of the vehicle at the time when it is first so used or first so converted, on the
value of it immediately before it was first so used or first so converted or
immediately after it was first so used or first so converted, whichever is the higher,
as if the vehicle had then been imported into Niue.
(4) Tax on any private motor vehicle referred to in subsection (3) shall,
under this Act, be payable once only.

Manufactured Goods Tax Act 1964

1033
(5) Where any private motor vehicle is hired out for money, or for any other reward or other valuable consideration, for a period of at least 3 months or for periods which in the aggregate, amount to a period of at least 3 months then, on the completion of such period of 3 months the vehicle shall, for the purposes of subsection (2) be deemed to have been disposed of by the person who imported the vehicle into Niue and shall, for the purposes of subsection (3), be deemed to have been converted for use as a trade motor.
(6) (a) The value at any particular time of any personal chattels or vehicle to which this section relates shall, for all or any of the purposes of this section, be assessed by the Revenue Manager.
(b) Any person interested who considers that any such assessment of value is excessive may, at any time within a period of 3 months after the date of issuing of any demand for payment of tax based on such assessment, appeal to the Court against the assessment and, after hearing any such appeal, the Court may either confirm the assessment or, if it thinks that the assessment is excessive, reduce the amount of it to a sum which it thinks proper and such demand for payment of tax shall be deemed to have been modified accordingly.
(c) The judgment of the Court on any such appeal shall be final.

7 Refunds

The amount of any tax paid under this Part by an importer may be refunded
upon application to the Treasurer if the goods on which the tax has been paid
have not been used or sold and the Treasurer is satisfied that they have been
exported from Niue.

8 Tax imposed

PART 3
TAX ON GOODS MANUFACTURED IN NIUE
The tax imposed on goods by Part 2 shall also be payable on the value (as defined in this Act) of all such goods as are manufactured in Niue and shall be paid to the Treasurer by the manufacturer before such goods are offered for sale.

9 Refunds

The amount of any tax paid under this Part by a manufacturer may be
refunded upon application to the Treasurer if the goods on which the tax has been
paid have not been used or sold and are surrendered if so required by the Treasurer
to the Revenue Manager for destruction.

10 Rules or regulations

PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
Cabinet may make such regulations as it may consider necessary for the proper application or enforcement of this Act.

10A New Zealand Representative Act 1981

The provisions of this Act shall not apply to any person entitled to privileges
and immunities under the New Zealand Representative Act 1981.

11 [Spent]

––––––––––––––––––––
1034 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

SCHEDULE

Goods Rates of Tax Payable

1

Preserved Fruit

5 per centum

2

Confectionery

5 per centum

3

Wines fermented and containing

more than 3 per cent proof spirit

10 per centum

4

Spirits and spiritous mixtures

10 per centum

5

Beer containing more than 2 per cent

proof spirit

10 per centum

6

Cameras

10 per centum on items over $20

C.D.V.

7

Radios and radiograms

10 per centum on items over $20

C.D.V.

8

Watches and Clocks

10 per centum on items over $40

C.D.V.

9

Jewellery

10 per centum on all items

10

Tobacco

5 per centum

11

Cigarettes

5 per centum

12

Motor vehicles

10 per centum

1035

MARINE INSURANCE ACT 1908

1908/112/(NZ) – 4 August 1908

1 Short title

2 Interpretation

Marine Insurance

3 Marine insurance defined mixed sea and

land risks

4 Marine adventure and maritime perils

defined

Insurable Interest

5 Avoidance of wagering or gaming contracts

6 Insurable interest defined

7 When interest must attach

8 Defeasible or contingent interest

9 Partial interest

10 Reinsurance

11 Bottomry

12 Master ’s and seamen’s wages

13 Advance freight

14 Charges of insurance

15 Quantum of interest

16 Assignment of interest

Insurable Value

17 Measure of insurable value

Disclosure and Representations

18 Disclosure by assured

19 Disclosure by agent effecting insurance

20 Representations pending negotiation of

contract

21 When contract is deemed to be concluded

The Policy

22 Contract must be embodied in policy

23 What policy must specify

24 Signature of insurer

25 Designation of subject-matter

26 Failure to execute and stamp policy

27 Voyage and time policies

28 Valued policy

29 Unvalued policy

30 Floating policy by ship or ships

31 Premium to be arranged

32 Construction of terms in policy

1036 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Partial Losses (Including Salvage and General

80

Right of contribution

Average and Particular Charges)

81

Effect of under-insurance

64

Particular average loss

65

Salvage charges

Return of Premium

66

General average loss

82

Enforcement of return

83

Return by agreement

Measure of Indemnity

84

Return for failure of consideration

67

Extent of liability of insurer for loss

68

Total loss

Mutual Insurance

69

Partial loss of ship

85

Modification of Act in case of mutual

70

Partial loss of freight

insurance

71

Partial loss of goods, merchandise

72

Apportionment of valuation

Supplemental

73

General average contributions and salvage

86

Ratification by assured

charges

87

Implied obligations varied by agreement or

74

Liabilities to third parties

usage

75

General provisions as to measure of

88

Reasonable time, a question of fact

indemnity

89

Application of common law

76

Particular average warranties

90

[Repealed]

77

Successive losses

78

Suing and labouring clause

SCHEDULES

Rights of Insurer on Payment

79

Right of subrogation

To consolidate certain enactments relating to marine insurance

1 Short Title

This is the Marine Insurance Act 1908.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“action” includes counterclaim and set-off;
“freight” includes the profit derivable by a shipowner from the employment
of his ship to carry his own goods or movables, as well as freight payable
by a third party, but does not include passage money;
“movables” means any movable tangible property other than the ship, and
includes money, valuable securities, and other documents;
“policy” means a marine policy.

Marine Insurance

3 Marine insurance defined, mixed sea and land risks

(1) A contact of marine insurance is a contract whereby the insurer
undertakes to indemnify the assured, in manner and to the extent thereby agreed,
against marine losses – that is to say, the losses incident to marine adventure.
(2) A contract of marine insurance may, by its express terms or by usage of
trade, be extended so as to protect the assured against losses on inland waters or
on any land risk which may be incidental to any sea voyage.
(3) Where a ship in course of building, or the launch of a ship, or any
adventure analogous to a marine adventure, is covered by a policy in the form of
a marine policy, the provisions of this Act, in so far as applicable, shall apply to it;
but, except as provided by this section, nothing in this Act shall alter or affect any
rule of law applicable to any contract of insurance other than a contract of marine
insurance as defined by this Act.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1037

4 Marine adventure and maritime perils defined

(1) Subject to this Act, every lawful marine adventure may be the subject
of a contract of marine insurance.
(2) In particular there is a marine adventure where –
(a) Any ship, goods, or other movables (“insurable property”) are
exposed to maritime perils;
(b) The earning or acquisition of any freight, passage money,
commission, profit, or other pecuniary benefit, or the security for
any advances, loan, or disbursements, is endangered by the
exposure of insurable property to the marine perils;
(c) Any liability to a third party may be incurred by the owner of, or
other person interested in or responsible for, insurable property by
reason of maritime perils.
(3) “Maritime perils” means the perils consequent on or incidental to the
navigation of the sea – perils of the seas, fire, war perils, pirates, rovers, thieves,
captures, seizures, restraints, and detainments of princes and peoples, jettisons,
barratry, and any other perils, either of the like kind or designated by the policy.

Insurable Interests

5 Avoidance of wagering or gaming contracts

(1) Every contract of marine insurance by way of gaming or wagering is
void.
(2) A contract of marine insurance is deemed to be a gaming or wagering
contract –
(a) Where the assured has not an insurable interest , and the contract is entered into with no expectation of acquiring such an interest; or
(b) Where the policy is made “interest or no interest”, or “without further proof of interest than the policy itself”, or “without benefit of salvage to the insurer”, or subject to any other like term.
(3) Where there is no possibility of salvage a policy may be effected without benefit of salvage to the insurer.

6 Insurable interest defined

(1) Subject to this Act, every person has an insurable interest who is
interested in a marine adventure.
(2) In particular a person is interested in a marine adventure where he
stands in any legal or equitable relation to the adventure, or to any insurable
property at risk therein, in consequence of which he may benefit by the safety of
or due arrival of insurable property, or may be prejudiced by its loss, or by damage
to it, or by the detention of it, or may incur liability in respect of it.

7 When interest must attach

(1) (a) The assured must be interested in the subject-matter insured at the
time of the loss, though he need not be interested when the insurance
is effected.
(b) Where the subject-matter is insured “lost or not lost”, the assured
may recover although he may not have acquired his interest until
after the loss, unless at the time of effecting the contract of insurance
the assured was aware of the loss and the insurer was not.
(2) Where the assured has no interest at the time of the loss, he cannot
acquire interest by any act or election after he is aware of the loss.
1038 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

8 Defeasible or contingent interest

(1) A defeasible interest is insurable, as also is a contingent interest.
(2) In particular, where the buyer of goods has insured them he has an
insurable interest, notwithstanding that he might at his election have rejected the
goods, or have treated them as at the seller ’s risk, by reason of the latter ’s delay in
making delivery or otherwise.

9 Partial interest

A partial interest of any nature is insurable.

10 Reinsurance

(1) The insurer under a contract of marine insurance has an insurable
interest in his risk, and may reinsure in respect of it.
(2) Unless the policy otherwise provides, the original assured has no right
or interest in respect of such reinsurance.

11 Bottomry

The lender of money on bottomry or respondentia has an insurable interest
in respect of the loan.

12 Master’s and seamen’s wages

The master or any member of the crew of a ship has an insurable interest in
respect of his wages.

13 Advance freight

In the case of advance freight, the person advancing the freight has an
insurable interest in so far as such freight is not repayable in case of loss.

14 Charges of insurance

The assured has an insurable interest in the charges of any insurance which
he may effect.

15 Quantum of interest

(1) Where the subject-matter insured is mortgaged, the mortgagor has an
insurable interest in the full value of it, and the mortgagee has an insurable interest
in respect of any sum due or to become due under the mortgage.
(2) A mortgagee, consignee, or other person having an interest in the
subject-matter insured may insure on behalf and for the benefit of other persons
interested as well as for his own benefit.
(3) The owner of insurable property has an insurable interest in respect of
the full value of it, notwithstanding that some third person may have agreed, or
be liable, to indemnify him in case of loss.

16 Assignment of interest

(1) Where the assured assigns or otherwise parts with his interest in the
subject-matter insured, he does not thereby transfer to the assignee his rights under
the contract of insurance, unless there is an express or implied agreement with the
assignee to that effect.
(2) The provisions of this section do not affect a transmission of interest by
operation of law.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1039

Insurable Value

17 Measure of insurable value

Subject to any express provision or valuation in the policy, the insurable
value of the subject-matter insured must be ascertained as follows:
(a) In insurance on ship the insurable value is the value, at the
commencement of the risk, of the ship, including her outfit,
provisions and stores for the officers and crew, money advanced
for seamen’s wages, and other disbursements (if any) incurred to
make the ship fit for the voyage or adventure contemplated by the
policy, plus the charges of insurance upon the whole; and, in the
case of a steamship, includes also the machinery, boilers, and coals
and engine stores if owned by the assured; and in the case of a ship
engaged in a special trade, the ordinary fittings requisite for that
trade;
(b) In insurance on freight, whether paid in advance or otherwise, the
insurable value is the gross amount of the freight at the risk of the
assured, plus the charges of insurance;
(c) In insurance on goods or merchandise the insurable value is the
prime cost of the property insured, plus the expenses of and
incidental to shipping and the charges of insurance upon the whole;
(d) In insurance on any other subject-matter the insurable value is the
amount at the risk of the assured when the policy attaches, plus the
charges of insurance.

Disclosure and Representations

18 Disclosure by assured

(1) Subject to this section, the assured must disclose to the insurer, before
the contract is concluded, every material circumstance known to the assured, and
the assured is deemed to know every circumstance which, in the ordinary course
of business, ought to be known by him. If the assured fails to make such a
disclosure, the insurer may avoid the contract.
(2) Every circumstance is material which would influence the judgment
of a prudent insurer in fixing the premium or determining whether he will take
the risk.
(3) In the absence of inquiry the following circumstances need not be
disclosed, namely:
(a) Any circumstance which diminishes the risk;
(b) Any circumstance known or presumed to be known to the insurer.
The insurer is presumed to know matters of common notoriety or
knowledge, and matters which an insurer in the ordinary course of
his business, as such, ought to know;
(c) Any circumstance as to which information is waived by the insurer;
(d) Any circumstance which is superfluous to disclose by reason of
any express or implied warranty.
(4) Whether any particular circumstance which is not disclosed is material
or not is in each case a question of fact.
(5) The term “circumstance” includes any communication made to or
information received by the assured.

19 Disclosure by agent effecting insurance

Subject to section 18 as to circumstances which need not be disclosed, where
an insurance is effected for the assured by an agent, the agent must disclose to the
insurer –
1040 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(a) Every material circumstance known to himself; and an agent to insure is deemed to know every circumstance which in the ordinary course of business ought to be known by him or to have been communicated to him; and
(b) Every material circumstance which the assured is bound to disclose, unless it comes to his knowledge too late to communicate it to an agent.

20 Representations pending negotiation of contract

(1) Every material representation made by the assured or his agent to the
insurer during the negotiations for the contract, and before the contract is
concluded, must be true. If it is untrue, the insurer may avoid the contract.
(2) A representation is material which would influence the judgment of a
prudent insurer in fixing the premium or determining whether he will take the
risk.
(3) A representation may be either a representation as to a matter of fact or as to a matter of expectation or belief.
(4) A representation as to a matter of fact is true if it is substantially correct
– ie if the difference between what is represented and what is actually correct
would not be considered material by a prudent insurer.
(5) A representation as to a matter of expectation or belief is true if it is
made in good faith.
(6) A representation may be withdrawn or corrected before the contract is
concluded.
(7) Whether a particular representation is material or not is in each case a
question of fact.

21 When contract is deemed to be concluded

A contract of marine insurance is deemed to be concluded when the
proposal of the assured is accepted by the insurer, whether the policy is then issued
or not; and for the purpose of showing when the proposal was accepted reference
may be made to the slip or covering note, or other customary memorandum of
the contract, although it is unstamped.

The Policy

22 Contract must be embodied in policy

(1) No action shall be brought on a contract of marine insurance unless it
is embodied in a marine policy under this Act.
(2) The policy may be executed and issued either at the time when the
contract is concluded or afterwards.

23 What policy must specify

A marine policy must specify –
(a) The name of the assured or of some person who effects the insurance
on his behalf;
(b) The subject-matter insured and the risk insured against;
(c) The voyage or period of time, or both, as the case may be, covered
by the insurance;
(d) The sum or sums insured;
(e) The name or names of the insurers.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1041

24 Signature of insurer

(1) (a) A marine policy must be signed by or on behalf of the insurer.
(b) In the case of a corporation the corporate seal may be sufficient,
but nothing in this section shall be construed as requiring the
subscription of a corporation to be under seal.
(2) Where a policy is subscribed by or on behalf of 2 or more insurers, each
subscription, unless the contrary is expressed, constitutes a distinct contract with
the assured.

25 Designation of subject-matter

(1) The subject-matter insured must be designated in a marine policy with
reasonable certainty.
(2) The nature and extent of the interest of the assured in the subject-matter
insured need not be specified in the policy.
(3) Where the policy designates the subject-matter insured in general terms,
it shall be construed to apply to the interest intended by the assured to be covered.
(4) In the application of this section regard shall be had to any usage
regulating the designation of the subject-matter insured.

26 Failure to execute and stamp policy

(1) If any person, whether as an insurer or as the agent of an insurer, directly
or indirectly receives or takes credit in account for any premium or consideration
for any contract of marine insurance, and does not before or within 30 days after
receiving or taking credit for such premium or consideration duly execute or
procure to be duly executed, a policy of such insurance, he shall be liable to a fine
of 2 penalty units.
(2) If any person, whether as an insurer or as the agent of an insurer, pays
any sum of money upon any loss under a contract of marine insurance which is
not expressed in a duly executed policy, or if he in any way settles any claim made
in respect of such a contract, he shall be liable to a fine of 2 penalty units.
(3) This section does not apply to contracts of reinsurance of risks in respect
whereof policies have been duly executed.
(4) This section applies to that agent of an insurer, whether such insurer
resides or carries on business in Niue or elsewhere.

27 Voyage and time policies

(1) (a) Where the contract is to insure the subject-matter at and from or
from one place to another or others, the policy is called a “voyage
policy” and where the contract is to insure the subject-matter for a
definite period of time, the policy is called a “time policy”.
(b) A contract for both voyage and time may be included in the same
policy.
(2) A time policy which is made for any time exceeding 12 months is invalid;
but a time policy may contain an agreement to the effect that, in the event of the
ship being at sea or the voyage otherwise not completed on the expiration of 12
months, the subject-matter of the insurance shall be held covered until the arrival
of the ship at her destination, or for a reasonable time after it not exceeding 30
days.

28 Valued policy

(1) A policy may be either valued or unvalued.
(2) A valued policy is a policy which specifies the agreed value of the
subject-matter insured.
1042 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) Subject to this Act, and in the absence of fraud, the value fixed by the policy is, as between the insurer and assured, conclusive of the insurable value of the subject intended to be insured, whether the loss is total or partial.
(4) Unless the policy otherwise provides, the value fixed by the policy is not conclusive for the purpose of determining whether there has been a constructive total loss.

29 Unvalued policy

An unvalued policy is a policy which does not specify the value of the
subject-matter insured, but, subject to the limit of the sum insured, leaves the
insurable value to be subsequently ascertained in the manner hereinbefore
specified.

30 Floating policy by ship or ships

(1) A floating policy is a policy which describes the insurance in general
terms, and leaves the name of the ship or ships and other particulars to be defined
by subsequent declaration.
(2) The subsequent declaration or declarations may be made by
endorsement on the policy or in other customary manner.
(3) Unless the policy otherwise provides, the declarations must be made
in the order of despatch or shipment. They must, in the case of goods, comprise
all consignments within the terms of the policy, and the value of the goods or
other property must be honestly stated, but an omission or erroneous declaration
may be rectified even after loss or arrival, provided the omission or declaration
was made in good faith.
(4) Unless the policy otherwise provides, where a declaration of value is
not made until after notice of loss or arrival, the policy must be treated as an
unvalued policy as regards the subject-matter of that declaration.

31 Premium to be arranged

(1) Where an insurance is effected at a premium to be arranged, and no
arrangement is made, a reasonable premium is payable.
(2) Where an insurance is effected on the terms that an additional premium
is to be arranged in a given event, and that event happens but no arrangement is
made, then a reasonable additional premium is payable.

32 Construction of terms in policy

Subject to this Act, and unless the context of the policy otherwise requires
the terms and expressions mentioned in Schedule 2 have, when contained in a
policy, the meaning and operation attributed to them in that Schedule.

33 Double insurance

Double Insurance

(1) Where 2 or more policies are effected by or on behalf of the assured on the same adventure and interest or any part of it, and the sums insured exceed the indemnity allowed by this Act, the assured is said to be over-insured by double insurance.
(2) Where the assured is over-insured by double insurance –
(a) The assured, unless the policy otherwise provides, may claim
payment from the insurers in such order as he thinks fit, provided
that he is not entitled to receive any sum in excess of the indemnity
allowed by this Act;

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1043
(b) Where the policy under which the assured claims is a valued policy, the assured must give credit as against the valuation for any sum received by him under any other policy, without regard to the actual value of the subject-matter insured;
(c) Where the policy under which the assured claims is an unvalued policy, he must give credit, as against the full insurable value, for any sum received by him under any other policy;
(d) Where the assured receives any sum in excess of the indemnity allowed by this Act, he is deemed to hold such sum in trust for the insurers, according to their right of contribution among themselves.

34 Nature of warranty

Warranties

(1) A warranty, in the following sections relating to warranties, means a promissory warranty – that is to say, a warranty by which the assured undertakes that some particular thing shall or shall not be done, or that some condition shall be fulfilled, or whereby he affirms or negatives the existence of a particular state of facts.
(2) A warranty may be express or implied.
(3) A warranty as above defined is a condition which must be exactly
complied with, whether material to the risk or not. If it is not so complied with,
then, subject to any express provision in the policy, the insurer is discharged from
liability as from the date of the breach or warranty, but without prejudice to any
liability incurred by him before that date.

35 When breach of warranty excused

(1) Non-compliance with a warranty is excused when, by reason of a
change of circumstances the warranty ceases to be applicable to the circumstances
of the contract, or when compliance with the warranty is rendered unlawful by
any subsequent law.
(2) Where a warranty is broken, the assured cannot avail himself of the
defence that the breach has been remedied, and the warranty complied with, before
loss.
(3) A breach of warranty may be waived by the insurer.

36 Express warranties

(1) An express warranty may be in any form of words from which the
intention to warrant is to be inferred.
(2) An express warranty must be included in or written upon this policy,
or must be contained in some document incorporated by reference into the policy.
(3) An express warranty does not exclude an implied warranty, unless it is
inconsistent therewith.

37 Warranty of neutrality

(1) Where insurable property, whether ship or goods, is expressly
warranted neutral, there is an implied condition that the property shall have a
neutral character at the commencement of the risk, and that so far as the assured
can control the matter, its neutral character shall be preserved during the risk.
(2) (a) Where a ship is expressly warranted neutral, there is also an implied
condition that, so far as the assured can control the matter, the ship
shall be properly documented – that she shall carry the necessary
papers to establish her neutrality, and that her papers shall not be
falsified or suppressed, and that simulated papers shall not be used.
(b) If any loss occurs through breach of this condition, the insurer may
avoid the contract.
1044 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

38 No implied warranty of nationality

There is no implied warranty as to the nationality of a ship, or that her
nationality shall not be changed during the risk.

39 Warranty of good safety

Where the subject-matter insured is warranted “well” or “in good safety”
on a particular day, it is sufficient if it is safe at any time during that day.

40 Warranty of seaworthiness of ship

(1) In a voyage policy there is an implied warranty that at the
commencement of the voyage the ship shall be seaworthy for the purpose of the
particular adventure insured.
(2) Where the policy attaches while the ship is in port, there is also an
implied warranty that she shall, at the commencement of the risk, be reasonably
fit to encounter the ordinary perils of the port.
(3) Where the policy relates to a voyage which is performed in different
stages, during which the ship requires different kinds of or further preparation or
equipment, there is an implied warranty that at the commencement of each stage
the ship is seaworthy in respect of such preparation or equipment for the purposes
of that stage.
(4) A ship is deemed to be seaworthy when she is reasonably fit in all
respects to encounter the ordinary perils of the seas of the adventure insured.
(5) In a time policy there is no implied warranty that the ship shall be
seaworthy at any stage of the adventure; but where, with the privity of the assured,
the ship is sent to sea in an unseaworthy state, the insurer is not liable for any loss
attributable to unseaworthiness.

41 No implied warranty that goods are seaworthy

(1) In a policy on goods or other movables there is no implied warranty
that the goods or movables are seaworthy.
(2) In a voyage policy on goods or other movables there is an implied
warranty that at the commencement of the voyage the ship is not only seaworthy
as a ship, but also that she is reasonably fit to carry the goods or other movables to
the destination contemplated by the policy.

42 Warranty of legality

There is an implied warranty that the adventure insured is a lawful one, and that,
so far as the assured can control the matter, the adventure shall be carried out in a
lawful manner.

The Voyage

43 Implied condition as to commencement of risk

(1) Where the subject-matter is insured by a voyage policy “at and from”
or “from” a particular place, it is not necessary that the ship should be at that
place when the contract is concluded, but there is an implied condition that the
adventure shall be commenced within a reasonable time, and that if the adventure
is not so commenced the insurer may avoid the contract.
(2) The implied condition may be negatived by showing that the delay
was caused by circumstances known to the insurer before the contract was
concluded, or that he waived the condition.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1045

44 Alteration of port of departure

Where the place of departure is specified by the policy, and the ship instead
of sailing from that place sails from any other place, the risk does not attach.

45 Sailing for different destination

Where the destination is specified in the policy, and the ship instead of sailing for
that destination sails for any other destination, the risk does not attach.

46 Change of voyage

(1) Where, after the commencement of the risk, the destination of the ship
is voluntarily changed from the destination contemplated by the policy, there is
said to be a change of voyage.
(2) Unless the policy otherwise provides, where there is a change of voyage
the insurer is discharged from liability as from the time of change – ie as from the
time when the determination to change it is manifested; and it is immaterial that
the ship may not in fact have left the course of voyage contemplated by the policy
when the loss occurs.

47 Deviation

(1) Where a ship without lawful excuse deviates from the voyage
contemplated by the policy, the insurer is discharged from liability as from the
time of deviation, and it is immaterial that the ship may have regained her route
before any loss occurs.
(2) There is a deviation from the voyage contemplated by the policy –
(a) Where the course of the voyage is specifically designated by the
policy, and that course is departed from; or
(b) Where the course of the voyage is not specifically designated by
the policy, but the usual and customary course is departed from.
(3) The intention to deviate is immaterial; there must be a deviation in fact
to discharge the insurer from his liability under the contract.

48 Several ports of discharge

(1) Where several ports of discharge are specified by the policy, the ship
may proceed to all or any of them, but in the absence of any usage or sufficient
cause to the contrary she must proceed to them, or such of them as she goes to, in
the order designated by the policy. If she does not, there is a deviation.
(2) Where the policy is to “ports of discharge” within a given area, which
are not named, the ship must, in the absence of any usage or sufficient cause to the
contrary, proceed to them, or such of them as she goes to, in their geographical
order. If she does not, there is a deviation.

49 Delay in voyage

In the case of a voyage policy the adventure insured must be prosecuted
throughout its course with reasonable despatch, and if without lawful excuse it is
not so prosecuted, the insurer is discharged from liability as from the time when
the delay became unreasonable.
1046 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

50 Excuses for deviation or delay

(1) Deviation or delay in prosecuting the voyage contemplated by the policy
is excused –
(a) Where authorised by any special term in the policy; or
(b) Where caused by circumstances beyond the control of the master
and his employer; or
(c) Where reasonably necessary in order to comply with an express or
implied warranty; or
(d) Where reasonably necessary for the safety of the ship or subject-
matter insured; or
(e) For the purpose of saving human life, or aiding a ship in distress
where human life may be in danger; or
(f) Where reasonably necessary for the purpose of obtaining medical
or surgical aid for any person on board the ship; or
(g) Where caused by the barratrous conduct of the master or crew, if
barratry is one of the perils insured against.
(2) When the cause excusing the deviation or delay ceases to operate, the
ship must resume her course and prosecute her voyage with reasonable despatch.

Assignment of Policy

51 When and how policy is assignable

(1) A marine policy is assignable unless it contains terms expressly
prohibiting assignment. It may be assigned either before or after loss.
(2) Where a marine policy has been assigned so as to pass the beneficial
interest in the policy, the assignee of the policy is entitled to sue thereon in his
own name; and the defendant is entitled to make any defence arising out of the
contract which he would have been entitled to make if the action had been brought
in the name of the person by or on behalf of whom the policy was effected.
(3) A marine policy may be assigned by endorsement thereon or in other
customary manner.

52 Assured who has no interest cannot assign

Where the assured has parted with or lost his interest in the subject-matter
insured, and has not, before or at the time of so doing, expressly or impliedly
agreed to assign the policy, any subsequent assignment of the policy is inoperative:
Provided that nothing in this section affects the assignment of a policy after loss.

The Premium

53 Policy effected through broker

(1) Unless otherwise agreed, where a marine policy is effected on behalf of
the assured by a broker, the broker is directly responsible to the insurer for the
premium, and the insurer is directly responsible to the assured for the amount
which may be payable in respect of losses or in respect of returnable premium.
(2) Unless otherwise agreed, the broker has, as against the assured, a lien
upon the policy for the amount of the premium and his charges in respect of
effecting the policy; and, where he has dealt with the person who employs him as
a principal, he has also a lien on the policy in respect of any balance on any
insurance account which may be due to him from such person, unless when the
debt was incurred he had reason to believe that such person was only an agent.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1047

54 Effect of receipt on policy

Where a marine policy effected on behalf of the assured by a broker
acknowledges the receipt of the premium, such acknowledgement is, in the absence
of fraud, conclusive as between the insurer and the assured, but not as between
the insurer and the broker.

Loss and Abandonment

55 Included and excluded losses

(1) Subject to this Act, and unless the policy otherwise provides, the insurer
is liable for any loss proximately caused by a peril insured against; but subject as
aforesaid, he is not liable for any loss not proximately caused by a peril insured
against.
(2) In particular –
(a) The insurer is not liable for any loss attributable to the wilful
misconduct of the assured; but unless the policy otherwise provides,
he is liable for any loss proximately caused by a peril insured against,
even though the loss would not have happened but for the
misconduct or negligence of the master or crew;
(b) Unless the policy otherwise provides, the insurer on ship or goods
is not liable for any loss proximately caused by delay, although the
delay is caused by a peril insured against;
(c) Unless the policy otherwise provides, the insurer is not liable for
ordinary wear and tear, ordinary leakage and breakage, inherent
vice or nature of the subject-matter insured, or for any loss
proximately caused by rats or vermin, or for any injury to machinery
not proximately caused by maritime perils.

56 Partial and total loss

(1) A loss may be either total or partial. Any loss other than a total loss, as
hereinafter defined, is a partial loss.
(2) A total loss may be either an actual total loss or a constructive total
loss.
(3) Unless a different intention appears from the terms of the policy, an
insurance against total loss includes a constructive as well as an actual total loss. (4) Where the assured brings an action for a total loss, and the evidence
proves only a partial loss, he may, unless the policy otherwise provides, recover for a partial loss.
(5) Where goods reach their destination in specie, but by reason of
obliteration of marks or otherwise they are incapable of identification, the loss (if
any) is partial and not total.

57 Actual total loss

(1) Where the subject-matter insured is destroyed, or so damaged as to
cease to be a thing of the kind insured, or where the assured is irretrievably
deprived of it, there is an actual total loss.
(2) In the case of an actual total loss no notice of abandonment need be
given.

58 Missing ship

Where the ship concerned in the adventure is missing, and after the lapse
of a reasonable time no news of her has been received, an actual total loss may be
presumed.
1048 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

59 Effect of transshipment

Where, by a peril insured against, the voyage is interrupted at an
intermediate port or place under such circumstances as, apart from any special
stipulation in the contract of affreightment, to justify the master in landing and
reshipping the goods or other movables, or in transshipping them, and sending
them on to their destination, the liability of the insurer continues,
notwithstanding the landing or transshipment.

60 Constructive total loss defined

(1) Subject to any express provision in the policy, there is a constructive
total loss where the subject-matter insured is reasonably abandoned on account
of its actual total loss appearing to be unavoidable, or because it could not be
preserved from actual total loss without an expenditure which would exceed its
value when the expenditure had been incurred.
(2) In particular there is a constructive total loss –
(a) Where the assured is deprived of the possession of his ship or goods
by a peril insured against, and
(i) it is unlikely that he can recover the ship or goods, as the case
may be, or
(ii) the cost of recovering the ship or goods would exceed their
value when recovered; or
(b) In the case of damage to a ship, where she is so damaged by a peril
insured against that the cost of repairing the damage would exceed
the value of the ship when repaired; or
(c) In the case of damage to goods, where the cost of repairing the
damage and forwarding the goods to their destination would exceed
their value on arrival.
(3) In estimating the cost of repairs, no deduction is to be made in respect
of general average contributions to those repairs payable by other interests, but
account is to be taken of the expense of future salvage operations and of any future
general average contributions to which the ship would be liable if repaired.

61 Effect of constructive total loss

Where there is a constructive total loss, the assured may either treat the
loss as a partial loss or abandon the subject-matter insured to the insurer and treat
the loss as if it were an actual total loss.

62 Notice of abandonment

(1) (a) Subject to this section, where the assured elects to abandon the
subject-matter insured to the insurer he must give notice of
abandonment.
(b) If he fails to do so, the loss can be treated only as a partial loss.
(2) Notice of abandonment may be given in writing, or by word of mouth,
or partly in writing and partly by word of mouth, and may be given in any terms
which indicate the intention of the assured to abandon his insured interest in the
subject-matter insured unconditionally to the insurer.
(3) Notice of abandonment must be given with reasonable diligence after
the receipt of reliable information of the loss, but where the information is of
doubtful character the assured is entitled to a reasonable time to make inquiry.
(4) Where notice of abandonment is properly given, the rights of the assured
are not prejudiced by the fact that the insurer refuses to accept the abandonment.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1049
(5) (a) The acceptance of an abandonment may be either express or implied from the conduct of the insurer.
(b) The mere silence of the insurer after notice is not an acceptance.
(6) (a) Where notice of abandonment is accepted, the abandonment is
irrevocable.
(b) The acceptance of the notice conclusively admits liability for the
loss and the sufficiency of the notice.
(7) Notice of abandonment is unnecessary where, at the time when the
assured receives information of the loss, there would be no possibility of benefit
to the insurer if notice were given to him.
(8) Notice of abandonment may be waived by the insurer.
(9) Where an insurer has reinsured his risk, no notice of abandonment need
be given by him.

63 Effect of abandonment

(1) Where there is a valid abandonment, the insurer is entitled to take over
the interest of the assured in whatever may remain of the subject-matter insured,
and all proprietary rights incidental to it.
(2) Upon the abandonment of a ship the insurer of it is entitled to any
freight which is in the course of being earned, and which is earned by her
subsequent to the casualty causing the loss, less the expenses of earning it incurred
after the casualty; and where the ship is carrying the owner ’s goods, the insurer is
entitled to a reasonable remuneration for the carriage of them subsequent to the
causalty causing the loss.

Partial Losses (Including Salvage and General Average and Particular Charges)

64 Particular average loss

(1) A particular average loss is a partial loss of the subject-matter insured,
which is caused by a peril insured against, and which is not a general average
loss.
(2) (a) Expenses incurred by or on behalf of the assured for the safety or preservation of the subject-matter insured, other than the general average and salvage charges are called particular charges.
(b) Particular charges are not included in particular average.

65 Salvage charges

(1) Subject to any express provision in the policy, salvage charges incurred
in preventing a loss by perils insured against may be recovered as a loss by those
perils.
(2) (a) “Salvage charges” means the charges recoverable under maritime law by a salvor independently of contract, and does not include the expenses of services in the nature of salvage rendered by the assured or his agents, or any person employed for hire by them, for the purpose of averting a peril insured against.
(b) Such expenses, where properly incurred, may be recovered as particular charges or as a general average loss, according to the circumstances under which they were incurred.

66 General average loss

(1) A general average loss is a loss caused by or directly consequential on
a general average act. It includes a general average expenditure as well as a general
average sacrifice.
1050 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) There is a general average act where any extraordinary sacrifice or expenditure is voluntarily and reasonably made or incurred in time of peril for the purpose of preserving the property imperilled in the common adventure.
(3) Where there is a general average loss, the party on whom it falls is entitled, subject to the conditions imposed by maritime law, to a rateable contribution from the other parties interested, and such contribution is called a general average contribution.
(4) Subject to any express provision in the policy, where the assured has incurred a general average expenditure he may recover from the insurer in respect of the proportion of the loss which falls upon him; and, in the case of a general average sacrifice, he may recover from the insurer in respect of the whole loss without having enforced his right of contribution from the other parties liable to contribute.
(5) Subject to any express provision in the policy, where the assured has paid or is liable to pay a general average contribution in respect of the subject insured he may recover it from the insurer.
(6) In the absence of express stipulation, the insurer is not liable for any general average loss or contribution where the loss was not incurred for the purpose of avoiding or in connection with the avoidance of a peril insured against.
(7) Where ship, freight, and cargo, or any 2 of those interests are owned by the same assured, the liability of the insurer in respect of general average losses or contributions is to be determined as if those subjects were owned by different persons.

Measure of Indemnity

67 Extent of liability of insurer for loss

(1) The sum which the assured can recover in respect of a loss on a policy
by which he is insured, in the case of an unvalued policy to the full extent of the
insurable value, or in the case of a valued policy to the full extent of the value
fixed by the policy, is called the measure of indemnity.
(2) Where there is a loss recoverable under the policy, the insurer, or each
insurer if there are more than one, is liable for such proportion of the measure of
indemnity as the amount of his subscription bears to the value fixed by the policy
in the case of a valued policy, or to the insurable value in the case of an unvalued
policy.

68 Total loss

Subject to this Act and to any express provision in the policy, where there is
a total loss of subject-matter insured –
(a) If the policy is a valued policy, the measure of indemnity is the sum
fixed by the policy;
(b) If the policy is an unvalued policy, the measure of indemnity is the
insurable value of the subject-matter insured.

69 Partial loss of ship

Where a ship is damaged, but is not totally lost, the measure of indemnity,
subject to any express provision in the policy is –
(a) Where the ship has been repaired, the assured is entitled to the
reasonable cost of the repairs, less the customary deductions, but
not exceeding the sum insured in respect of any one casualty;
(b) Where the ship has been only partially repaired, the assured is
entitled to the reasonable cost of such repairs, computed as above,

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1051
and also to be indemnified for the reasonable depreciation (if any) arising from the unrepaired damage, provided that the aggregate amount shall not exceed the cost of repairing the whole damage, computed as above;
(c) Where the ship has not been repaired, and has not been sold in her damaged state during the risk, the assured is entitled to be indemnified for the reasonable depreciation arising from the unrepaired damage, but not exceeding the reasonable cost of repairing such damage, computed as above.

70 Partial loss of freight

Subject to any express provision in the policy, where there is a partial loss
of freight the measure of indemnity is such proportion of the sum fixed by the
policy in the case of a valued policy, or of the insurable value in the case of an
unvalued policy, as the proportion of freight lost by the assured bears to the whole
freight at the risk of the assured under the policy.

71 Partial loss of goods, merchandise

Where there is a partial loss of goods, merchandise, or other movables, the
measure of indemnity, subject to any express provision in the policy is –
(a) Where part of the goods, merchandise, or other movables insured
by a valued policy is totally lost, the measure of indemnity is such
proportion of the sum fixed by the policy as the insurable value of
the part lost bears to the insurable value of the whole, ascertained
as in the case of an unvalued policy;
(b) Where part of the goods, merchandise, or other movables insured
by and unvalued policy is totally lost, the measure of indemnity is
the insurable value of the part lost, ascertained as in the case of
total loss;
(c) Where the whole or any part of the goods or merchandise insured
has been delivered damaged at its destination, the measure of
indemnity is such proportion of the sum fixed by the policy in the
case of a valued policy, or of the insurable value in the case of an
unvalued policy, as the difference between the gross sound and
damaged values at the place of arrival bears to the gross sound
value;
(d) “Gross value” means the wholesale price or, if there is no such price,
the estimated value, with in either case freight, landing charges,
and duty paid beforehand; provided that, in the case of goods or
merchandise customarily sold in bond, the bonded price is deemed
to be the gross value.

72 Apportionment of valuation

(1) Where different species of property are insured under a single valuation,
the valuation must be apportioned over the different species in proportion to their
respective insurable values, as in the case of an unvalued policy.
(2) The insured value of any part of a species is such proportion of the
total insured value of the same as the insurable value of the part bears to the
insurable value of the whole, ascertained in both cases as provided by this Act.
(3) Where a valuation has to be apportioned, and particulars of the prime
cost of each separate species, quality, or description of goods cannot be ascertained,
the division of the valuation may be made over the net arrived sound values of
the different species, qualities, or descriptions of goods.
1052 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

73 General average contributions and salvage charges

(1) Subject to any express provision in the policy, where the assured has
paid or is liable for any general average contribution the measure of indemnity is
the full amount of such contribution if the subject-matter liable to contribution is
insured for its full contributory value, but if such subject-matter is not insured for
its full contributory value, or if only part of it is insured, the indemnity payable by
the insurer must be reduced in proportion to the under-insurance, and where
there has been a particular average loss which constitutes a deduction from the
contributory value, and for which the insurer is liable, that amount must be
deducted from the insured value in order to ascertain what the insurer is liable to
contribute.
(2) Where the insurer is liable for salvage charges, the extent of his liability
must be determined on the like principle.

74 Liabilities to third parties

Where the assured has effected an insurance in express terms against any
liability to a third party, the measure of indemnity, subject to any express provision
in the policy, is the amount paid or payable by him to such third party in respect
of such liability.

75 General provisions as to measure of indemnity

(1) Where there has been a loss in respect of any subject-matter not expressly
provided for in the foregoing provisions of this Act, the measure of indemnity
shall be ascertained, as nearly as may be, in accordance with those provisions, in
so far as applicable to the particular case.
(2) Nothing in this Act relating to the measure of indemnity shall affect
the rules relating to double insurance, or prohibit the insurer from disproving
interest wholly or in part, or from showing that at the time of the loss the whole or
any part of the subject-matter insured was not at risk under the policy.

76 Particular average warranties

(1) Where the subject-matter insured is warranted free from particular
average, the assured cannot recover for a loss of part, other than a loss incurred by
a general average sacrifice, unless the contract contained in the policy is
apportionable; but if the contract is apportionable, the assured may recover for a
total loss of any apportionable part.
(2) Where the subject-matter insured is warranted free from particular
average, either wholly or under a certain percentage, the insurer is nevertheless
liable for salvage charges, and for particular charges and other expenses properly
incurred under the provisions of the suing and labouring clause in order to avert
a loss insured against.
(3) Unless the policy otherwise provides, where the subject-matter insured
is warranted free from particular average under a specified percentage, a general
average loss cannot be added to a particular average loss to make up the specified
percentage.
(4) For the purpose of ascertaining whether the specified percentage has
been reached, regard shall be had only to the actual loss suffered by the subject-
matter insured. Particular charges and the expenses of and incidental to
ascertaining and proving the loss must be excluded.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1053

77 Successive losses

(1) Unless the policy otherwise provides, and subject to this Act, the insurer
is liable for successive losses, even though the total amount of such losses may
exceed the sum insured.
(2) Where under the same policy a partial loss which has not been repaired
or otherwise made good is followed by a total loss, the assured can only recover
in respect of the total loss.
(3) Nothing in this section shall affect the liability of the insurer under the
suing and labouring clause.

78 Suing and labouring clause

(1) Where the policy contains a suing and labouring clause, the engagement
entered into by it is deemed to be supplementary to the contract of insurance, and
the assured may recover from the insurer any expenses properly incurred under
the clause, notwithstanding that the insurer may have paid for a total loss, or that
the subject-matter may have been warranted free from particular average, either
wholly or under a certain percentage.
(2) General average losses and contributions and salvage charges, as
defined by this Act, are not recoverable under the suing and labouring clause.
(3) Expenses incurred for the purpose of averting or diminishing any loss
not covered by the policy are not recoverable under the suing and labouring clause.
(4) It is the duty of the assured and his agents in all cases to take such
measures as may be reasonable for the purpose of averting or minimising a loss.

Rights of Insurer on Payment

79 Right of subrogation

(1) Where the insurer pays for a total loss either of the whole, or, in the
case of goods, of any apportionable part of the subject-matter insured, he becomes
entitled to take over the interest of the assured in whatever may remain of the
subject-matter so paid for, and he is subrogated to all the rights and remedies of
the assured in and in respect of that subject-matter as from the time of the casualty
causing the loss.
(2) Subject to the foregoing provisions, where the insurer pays for a partial
loss he acquires no title to the subject-matter insured, or such part of it as may
remain, but his is subrogated to all rights and remedies of the assured in and in
respect of the subject-matter insured as from the time of the casualty causing the
loss, in so far as the assured has been indemnified, according to this Act, by such
payment for the loss.

80 Right of contribution

(1) Where the assured is over-insured by double insurance, each insurer is
bound, as between himself and the other insurers, to contribute ratably to the loss
in proportion to the amount for which he is liable under his contract.
(2) If any insurer pays more than his proportion of the loss, he is entitled
to maintain an action for contribution against the other insurers, and is entitled to
the like remedies as a surety who has paid more than his proportion of the debt.

81 Effect of under-insurance

Where the assured is insured for an amount less than the insurable value,
or, in the case of a valued policy, for an amount less than the policy valuation, he
is deemed to be his own insurer in respect of the uninsured balance.
1054 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

82 Enforcement of return

Return of Premium

Where the premium or a proportionate part of it is by this Act declared to be returnable –
(a) If already paid, it may be recovered by the assured from the insurer;
and
(b) If unpaid, it may be retained by the assured or his agent.

83 Return by agreement

Where the policy contains a stipulation for the return of the premium or a
proportionate part of it on the happening of a certain event, and that event happens,
the premium or the proportionate parts is returnable to the assured.

84 Return for failure of consideration

(1) Where the consideration for the payment of the premium totally fails,
and there has been no fraud or illegality on the part of the assured or his agents,
the premium is returnable to the assured.
(2) Where the consideration for the payment of the premium is
apportionable, and there is a total failure of any apportionable part of the
consideration, a proportionate part of the premium is under the like conditions
returnable to the assured.
(3) In particular –
(a) Where the policy is void, or is avoided by the insurer as from the
commencement of the risk, the premium is returnable, provided
that there has been no fraud or illegality on the part of the assured;
but if the risk is not apportionable, and has once been attached, the
premium is not returnable;
(b) Where the subject-matter insured or part of it has never been
imperilled, the premium or a proportionate part is returnable:
Provided that where the subject-matter has been insured “lost or
not lost”, and has arrived in safety at the time when the contract is
concluded, the premium is not returnable unless at such time the
insurer knew of the safe arrival;
(c) Where the assured has no insurable interest throughout the currency
of the risk, the premium is returnable; provided that this rule does
not apply to a policy effected by way of gaming or wagering;
(d) Where the assured has a defeasible interest which is terminated
during the currency of the risk, the premium is not returnable;
(e) Where the assured has overinsured under an unvalued policy, a
proportionate part of the premium is returnable;
(f) Subject to the foregoing where the assured has over-insured by
double insurance, a proportionate part of several premiums is
returnable:
Provided that if the policies are effected at different times, and any
earlier policy has at any time borne the entire risk, or if a claim has
been paid on the policy in respect of the full sum insured no
premium is returnable in respect of that policy; and when the double
insurance is effected knowingly by the assured, no premium is
returnable.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1055

Mutual Insurance

85 Modification of Act in case of mutual insurance

(1) Where 2 or more persons mutually agree to insure each other against
marine losses there is said to be a mutual insurance.
(2) The provisions of this Act relating to the premium do not apply to
mutual insurance, but a guarantee, or such other arrangement as may be agreed
upon, may be substituted for the premium.
(3) The provisions of this Act, in so far as they may be modified by the
agreement of the parties, may in the case of mutual insurance be modified by the
terms of the policies issued by the association, or by the rules and regulations of
the association.
(4) Subject to subsections (2) and (3) this Act applies to a mutual insurance.

86 Ratifications by assured

Supplemental

Where a contract of marine insurance is in good faith effected by one person on behalf of another, the person on whose behalf it is effected may ratify the contract even after he is aware of the loss.

87 Implied obligation varied by agreement or usage

(1) Where any right, duty, or liability would arise under a contract of marine
insurance by implication of law, it may be negatived or varied by express
agreement, or by usage, if the usage be such as to bind both parties to the contract.
(2) The provisions of this section extend to any right, duty, or liability
declared by this Act which may be lawfully modified by agreement.

88 Reasonable time, a question of fact

Where by this Act any reference is made to reasonable time, reasonable
premium, or reasonable diligence, the question what is reasonable is a question of
fact.

89 Application of common law

The rules of the common law including the law merchant, save in so far as
they are inconsistent with the express provisions of this Act, shall continue to
apply to contracts of marine insurance.

90 [Repealed 3/11/1960 (NZ)]

––––––––––––––––––––
1056 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

[Spent]

––—–––––––––––– SCHEDULE 2

Section 32

Rules for the Construction of Policies

The following are the rules referred to by this Act for the construction of a policy where

the context does not otherwise require:

1 Where the subject-matter is insured “lost or not lost”, and the loss has occurred

before the contract is concluded, the risk attaches unless at such time the assured was

aware of the loss and the insurer was not.

2 Where the subject-matter is insured “from” a particular place, the risk does not

attach until the ship starts on the voyage insured.

3 (a) Where a ship is insured “at and from” a particular place, and she is at that

place in goods safety when the contract is concluded, the risk attaches

immediately.

(b) If she is not at that place when the contract is concluded the risk attaches as

soon as she arrives there in good safety; and, unless the policy otherwise

provides, it is immaterial that she is covered by another policy for a specified

time after arrival.

(c) Where chartered freight is insured “at and from” a particular place, and the

ship is at that place in good safety when the contract is concluded, the risk

attaches immediately. If she is not there when the contract is concluded, the

risk attaches as soon as she arrives there in good safety.

(d) Where freight other than chartered freight is payable without special

conditions, and is insured “at and from” a particular place, the risk attaches

pro rata as the goods or merchandise are shipped; provided that if there is

cargo in readiness which belongs to the shipowner, or which some other person

has contracted with him to ship, the risk attaches as soon as the ship is ready

to receive such cargo.

4 Where goods or other movables are insured “from the loading thereof”, the risk

does not attach until such goods or movables are actually on board, and the insurer is not

liable for them while in transit from the shore to the ship.

5 Where the risk on goods or other movables continues until they are “safely landed”,

they must be landed in the customary manner and within a reasonable time after arrival

at the port of discharge, and if they are not so landed the risk ceases.

6 In the absence of any further licence or usage, the liberty to touch and stay “at any

port or place whatsoever” does not authorise the ship to depart from the course of her

voyage from the port of departure to the port of destination.

7 The term “perils of the seas” refers only to fortuitous accidents or causalities of

the seas. It does not include the ordinary action of the winds and waves.

8 The term “pirates” includes passengers who mutiny and rioters who attack the

ship form the shore.

9 The term “thieves” does not cover clandestine theft of theft committed by any

one of the ship’s company, whether crew or passengers.

10 The term “arrest, etc. of kings, princes, and people” refers to political or executive

acts, and does not include a loss caused by riot or by ordinary judicial process.

11 The term “barratry” includes every wrongful act wilfully committed by the master

or crew to the prejudice of the owner, or as the case may be, the charterer.

12 The term “all other perils” includes only perils similar in kind to the perils

specifically mentioned in the policy.

Marine Insurance Act 1908

1057

13 The term “average unless general” means a partial loss of the subject-matter insured other than a general average loss, and does not include “particular charges”.

14 When a policy contains the words “warranted free from particular average unless the ship is stranded, sunk or burnt”, or any similar expression, and any such accident has happened to the ship, the insurer is liable for the expected losses, although the loss is not attributable to such accident, provided that when the accident occurs the risk has attached and (if the policy is on goods) the damaged goods are on board.

15 The term “ship” includes the hull, materials and outfit, stores and provisions for the officers and crew, and, in the case of vessels engaged in a special trade, the ordinary fittings requisite for the trade; and also, in the case of a steamship, the machinery, boilers, and coals and engine stores, if owned by the assured.

16 The term “freight” includes the profit derivable by a shipowner from the employment of his ship to carry his own goods or movables, as well as freight payable by a third party, but does not include passage money.

17 The term “goods” means goods in the nature of merchandise, and does not include personal effects or provisions and stores, for the use on board.

18 In the absence of any usage to the contrary, deck cargo and living animals must be insured specifically, and not under the general denomination of goods.

1058 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

1059

MERCANTILE LAW ACT 1908

1908/117 (NZ) – 4 August 1908

25 Right of warehouse owner, if no notice is given, to pay deposit to shipowner

26 Course to be taken if notice to retain is given

26A Arbitration deemed to be legal proceedings

27 After 90 days warehouse owner may sell

goods by public auction

28 Notices of sale to be given

29 Moneys arising from sale, how to be

applied

30 Warehouse owner ’s rent and expenses

31 Warehouse owner ’s protection

15A “Received for shipment” bills of lading

16 When master may be exonerated from

liability

PART 3

CARRIERS

17–20 [Repealed]

PART 4

DELIVERY OF GOODS AND LIEN FOR FREIGHT

21 Interpretation

22 Power to shipowner to enter and land

goods in default of entry and landing by

owner of goods

23 Continuation of lien for freight if shipowner

gives notice

24 Lien to be discharged on deposit with

warehouse owner

PART 5

UNPAID VENDORS OF WAREHOUSED GOODS

32 Interpretation

33 Unpaid vendor ’s lien determined on

delivery of bond warrants to bona fide

holder for value

34 Possession of warrants prima facie evidence

of ownership

35 Holder of warrant entitled to delivery

36 Registered holder of warrant deemed to be

owner

37 Lien of registered transferee of warrant

determined on delivery of warrant bona fide

and for value

38 Warrants of free goods put on the same

footing as bond warrants

39 Provisions same in respect of bonded and

free warehouses

40 Vendor ’s lien not prejudiced save as against

bona fide subpurchaser or pledgee for value

41 Goods not to be transferred in books of

warehouseman except on production of

warrants

42 Special contracts restraining negotiability

of warrants

43 Warehouseman’s lien not prejudiced by

sale or transfer of goods

PART 6

BOOK PURCHASERS PROTECTION

44 Validity of agreements for purchase of

books

1060 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

To consolidate certain enactments relating to trade and commerce

1 Short title

This is the Mercantile Law Act 1908.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Part –
PART I MERCANTILE AGENTS
“document of title” includes any bill of lading, dock warrant, warehouse keeper ’s certificate, and warrant or order for the delivery of goods, and any other document used in the ordinary course of business as proof of the possession or control of goods, or authorising or purporting to authorise, either by endorsement or by delivery, the possessor of the document to transfer or receive goods thereby represented;
“goods” includes wares and merchandise;
“mercantile agent” means an agent having in the customary course of his
business as such agent authority either to sell goods, or to consign goods
for the purpose of sale, or to buy goods, or to consign goods for the
purpose of sale, or to buy goods, or to raise money on the security of
goods;
“pledge” includes any contract pledging or giving a lien or security on
goods, whether in consideration of an original advance, or of any further
or continuing advance, or of any pecuniary liability.
(2) A person shall be deemed to be in possession of goods, or of the
documents of title of goods, where the goods or documents are in his actual custody,
or are held by any other person subject to his control or for him on his behalf.

3 Powers of mercantile agent with respect to disposition of goods

(1) Where a mercantile agent is, with the consent of the owner, in possession
of goods or of the documents of title to goods, any sale, pledge, or other disposition
of the goods made by him when acting in the ordinary course of business of a
mercantile agent shall, subject to this Part be as valid as if he were expressly
authorised by the owner of the goods to make the same; provided that the person
taking under the disposition acts in good faith, and has not at the time of the
disposition notice that the person making the disposition has not authority to
make the same.
(2) Where a mercantile agent has, with the consent of the owner, been in
possession of goods or of the documents of title to goods, any sale, pledge, or
other disposition which would have been valid if the consent had continued to be
valid notwithstanding the determination of the consent, provided that the person
taking under the disposition has not at the time thereof notice that the consent has
been determined.
(3) Where a mercantile agent has obtained possession of any documents
of title to goods by reason of his being or having been, with the consent of the
owner, in possession of the goods represented by it, or any other documents of
title to the goods, his possession of the first mentioned documents shall, for the
purposes of this Part be deemed to be with the consent of the owner.
(4) For the purposes of this Part, the consent of the owner shall be presumed
in the absence of evidence to the contrary.

Mercantile Law Act 1908

1061

4 Effect of pledges of documents

A pledge of the documents of title to goods shall be deemed to be a pledge
of the goods.

5 Pledge for antecedent debt

Where a mercantile agent pledges goods as security for debt or liability
due from the pledgor to the pledgee before the time of the pledge, the pledgee
shall acquire no further right to the goods than could have been enforced by the
pledgor at the time of the pledge.

6 Rights acquired by exchange of goods or documents

The consideration necessary for the validity of a sale, pledge, or other
disposition of goods under this Part may be either a payment in cash, or the delivery
or transfer of other goods, or of a document of title to goods, or of a negotiable
security, or any other valuable consideration; but where goods are pledged by a
mercantile agent in consideration of the delivery or transfer of other goods, or of
a document of title to goods, or of a negotiable security, the pledgee shall acquire
no right or interest in the goods so pledged in excess of the value of the goods,
documents, or security when so delivered or transferred in exchange.

7 Agreements through clerks

For the purpose of this Part an agreement made with a mercantile agent
through a clerk or other person authorised in the ordinary course of business to
make contracts of sale or pledge on his behalf shall be deemed to be an agreement
with the agent.

8 Provisions as to consignors and consignees

(1) Where the owner of goods has given possession of the goods to another
person for the purpose of consignment or sale, or has shipped the goods in the
name of another person, and the consignee of the goods has not had notice that
such person is not the owner of the goods, the consignee shall, in respect of
advances made to or for the use of such person, have the same lien on the goods
as if such person were the owner of the goods, and may transfer any such lien to
another person.
(2) Nothing in this section shall limit or affect the validity of any sale,
pledge, or disposition by a mercantile agent.

9 Effect of transfer of document of title to goods on vendor’s lien and right of stoppage in transitu

(1) Where a document of title to goods has been lawfully transferred to a person as a buyer or owner of the goods, and that person transfers the document to a person who take the document in good faith and for valuable consideration, the last mentioned transfer shall have the same effect for defeating any vendor ’s lien of right of stoppage in transitu as the transfer of a bill of lading has for defeating the right of stoppage in transitu.
(2) This section shall be construed subject to section 48 of the Sale of Goods
Act 1908.
1062 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

10 Mode of transferring documents

For the purposes of this Part the transfer of a document may be by
endorsement, or where the document is by custom or by its express terms
transferable by delivery, or makes the goods deliverable to the bearer, then by
delivery.

11 Saving of rights of true owner

Nothing in this Part shall –
(a) Authorise a mercantile agent to exceed or depart from his authority
as between himself and his principal, or exempt him from any
liability, civil or criminal, for so doing; or
(b) Prevent the owner of goods from recovering the goods from a
mercantile agent or his trustee in bankruptcy at any time before the
sale or pledge; or
(c) Prevent the owner of goods pledged by a mercantile agent from
having the right to redeem the goods at any time before the sale of
it on satisfying the claim for which the goods were pledged and
paying to the mercantile agent, if by him required, any money in
respect of which such agent would by law be entitled to retain the
goods or the documents of title thereto, or any of them, by way of
lien as against the owner, or from recovering from any person with
whom the goods have been pledged any balance of money
remaining in his hands as the produce of the sale of the goods after
deducting the amount of his lien; or
(d) Prevent the owner of goods sold by a mercantile agent from
recovering from the buyer the price agreed to be paid for the same,
or any part of that price, subject to any right of set-off on the part of
the buyer against such agent.

12 Saving for common law powers of mercantile agent

This Part shall be construed in amplification and not in derogation of the
powers exercisable by a mercantile agent independently of this Part.
PART 2
BILLS OF LADING

13 Rights of action and liabilities to vest in consignees and endorsees

Every consignee of goods named in a bill of lading, and every endorsee of
a bill of lading, to whom the property in the goods therein mentioned passes on
or by reason of such consignment or endorsement, shall have transferred to and
vested in him all rights of action, and be subject to the same liabilities, in respect
of such goods as if the contract contained in the bill of lading had been made with
himself.

14 Right of stoppage in transitu or claims for freight not affected

Nothing herein shall prejudice or affect any right of stoppage in transitu, or
any right to claim freight against the original shipper or owner, or any liability of
the consignee or endorsee by reason or in consequence of his being such consignee
or endorsee or of his receipt of the goods by reason or in consequence of such
consignment or endorsement.

Mercantile Law Act 1908

1063

15 Bill of lading in hands of consignee

Every bill of lading in the hands of the shipper or of a consignee or endorsee
for valuable consideration, representing goods to have been shipped on board a
vessel, shall be conclusive evidence of such shipment as against the master or
other person signing the same, notwithstanding that such goods or some part
thereof may not have been so shipped, unless such holder of the bill of lading has
had actual notice at the time of receiving the same that the goods were not in fact
laden on board.

15A “Received for shipment” bills of lading

(1) In this section “received for shipment” bill of lading means a shipping
document issued under this section, signed by a person purporting to be authorised
to sign the same, and acknowledging that the goods to which the document relates
have been received for shipment.
(2) No “received for shipment” bill of lading shall be issued –
(a) Until the goods are in possession of the owner of the ship or of
some person duly authorised on his behalf;
(b) Except for a named ship in which space has been actually reserved;
(c) Earlier than 21 days before the time when the ship is expected to be
in port in readiness to load,
but the issue of a “received for shipment” bill of lading shall be sufficient evidence
until the contrary is proved that the requirements of this subsection have been
complied with.
(3) Every “received for shipment” bill of lading shall contain a provision
that, in the event of the goods being unavoidably shut out from the named ship,
the shipowner shall forward the goods by his next available ship, or, at his option,
by a ship of some other owner, or by a ship sailing within a specified number of
days, but otherwise on the same terms and conditions, mutatis mutandis, as if the
goods were actually shipped by the named ship.
(4) Every “received for shipment” bill of lading shall for all purposes be
deemed to be a valid bill of lading with the same effect and capable of negotiation
in all respects and with the same consequences as if it were a bill of lading
acknowledging that the goods to which it relates had been actually shipped on
board.

16 When master may be exonerated from liability

The master or other person so signing any bill of lading may exonerate
himself in respect of such misrepresentation by showing that it was caused without
any default on his part, and wholly by the fraud of the shipper or of the holder, or
some person under whom the holder claims.

17–20 [Repealed]

PART 3
PART 4
DELIVERY OF GOODS, AND LIEN FOR FREIGHT

21 Interpretation

In this Part –
“entry” means the entry required by the customs laws to be made for the
landing or discharge of goods from an importing ship;
“goods” includes every description of wares and merchandise;
1064 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“owner of goods” includes every person who is for the time being entitled, either as owner or agent for the owner, to the possession of the goods, subject in the case of a lien to such a lien;
“report” means the report required by the customs laws to be made by the master of any importing ship;
“shipowner” includes the master of the ship and every other person
authorised to act as agent for the owner or entitled to receive the freight,
demurrage, or other charges payable in respect of such ship;
“warehouse” includes all warehouses, buildings and premises in which
goods when landed from ships may be lawfully placed;
“warehouse owner” means the occupier of any warehouse as earlier
defined;
“wharf” includes all wharves, quays, docks, and premises in or upon which
any goods when landed from ships may be lawfully placed;
“wharf owner” means the occupier of any wharf.

22 Power to shipowner to enter and land goods in default of entry and landing by owner of goods

Where the owner of goods imported from foreign parts into Niue fails to make entry of it, or, having made entry of it, to land the same or take delivery of it, and to proceed with all convenient speed by the times severally mentioned in this section, the shipowner may make entry of and land or unship the said goods at the times, in the manner, and subject to the conditions following:
(a) If a time for the delivery of the goods is expressed in the charterparty,
bill of lading, or agreement, then at any time after the time so
expressed:
(b) If no time for the delivery of the goods is expressed in the
charterparty, bill of lading, or agreement, then at any time after the
expiration of 72 hours exclusive of a holiday, after the report of the
ship:
(c) If any wharf or warehouse is named in the charterparty, bill of
lading, or agreement as the wharf or warehouse where the goods
are to be placed, and if they can be conveniently there received, the
shipowner in landing them by virtue of this enactment shall cause
them to be placed on such a wharf or in such a warehouse;
(d) In other cases the shipowner, in landing goods by virtue of this
enactment, shall place them on or in some wharf or warehouse on
or in which goods of a like nature are usually placed, such wharf or
warehouse being, if the goods are dutiable, a wharf or warehouse
duly approved by the Minister of Customs for the landing of
dutiable goods;
(e) If at any time before the goods are landed or unshipped the owner
of the goods is ready and offers to land and take delivery of the
same, he shall be allowed so to do, and his entry shall in such case
be preferred to any entry made by the shipowner;
(f) If any goods are for the purpose of convenience in assorting the
same landed at the wharf where the ship is discharged, and the
owner of the goods at the time of such landing has made entry and
is ready and offers to take delivery of it and to convey the same to
some other wharf or warehouse, such goods shall be assorted at
landing; and shall if demanded, be delivered to the owner of it
within 24 hours after assortment, and the expense of and consequent

Mercantile Law Act 1908

1065
on such landing and assortment shall be borne by the shipowner; (g) If at any time before the goods are landed or unshipped the owner of it has made entry for the landing and warehousing of it at any particular wharf or warehouse other than that at which the ship is discharging and has offered and been ready to take delivery of it,
and the shipowner has failed to make such delivery, and has also
failed at the time of such offer to give the owner of the goods correct
information of the time at which such goods can be delivered, then
the shipowner shall, before landing or unshipping such goods under
the power hereby given to him, give the owner of the goods or of
such wharf or warehouse as last mentioned 24 hours’ notice in
writing of his readiness to deliver the goods, and shall, if he lands
or unships the same without such notice, do so at his own risk and
expense.

23 Continuation of lien for freight if shipowner gives notice

(1) If at any time when any goods are landed from any ship and placed in
the custody of any person as a wharf or warehouse owner the shipowner gives to
the wharf or warehouse owner notice in writing that the goods are to remain
subject to a lien for freight or other charges payable to the shipowner to an amount
to be mentioned in such notice, the goods so landed shall in the hands of the
wharf or warehouse owner continue liable to the same lien, if any, for such charges
as they were subject to before the landing.
(2) The wharf or warehouse owner receiving such goods shall retain them
until the lien is discharged as mentioned, and if he fails so to do shall make good
to the shipowner any loss thereby occasioned to him.
(3) On production to the wharf or warehouse owner of a receipt for the
amount claimed as due, and delivery to the wharf or warehouse owner of a copy
of it or a release of freight from the shipowner, the said lien shall be discharged.

24 Lien to be discharged on deposit with warehouse owner

The owner of the goods may deposit with the wharf or warehouse owner a
sum of money equal in amount to the sum so claimed by the shipowner and
thereupon the lien shall be discharged, but without prejudice to any other remedy
which the shipowner may have for the recovery of the freight.

25 Right of warehouse owner, if no notice is given, to pay deposit to shipowner

If such deposit is made with the wharf or warehouse owner and the person making the same does not within 15 days after making it give the wharf or warehouse owner notice in writing to retain it, stating in such notice the sum, if any, which he admits to be payable to the shipowner, or that he does not admit any sum to be so payable, the wharf or warehouse owner may at the expiration of such 15 days pay the sum so deposited over to the shipowner, and shall by such payment be discharged from all liability in respect of it.

26 Course to be taken if notice to retain is given

If such deposit is made with the wharf or warehouse owner, and the person
making the same does within 15 days after making it give to the wharf or
warehouse owner notice as aforesaid;
1066 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(a) The wharf or warehouse owner shall immediately apprise the shipowner of such notice, and shall pay or tender to him out of the sum deposited the sum admitted by such notice to be payable, and shall retain the balance or, if no sum is admitted to be payable, the whole of the sum deposited for 30 days from the date of the said notice;
(b) At the expiration of such 30 days, unless legal proceedings have in the meantime been instituted by the shipowner against the owner of the goods to recover the said balance or sum, or otherwise for the settlement of any disputes between them concerning such freight or other charges as aforesaid, and notice in writing of such proceedings has been served on him, the wharf or warehouse owner shall pay the said balance or sum over to the owner of the goods, and shall by such payment be discharged from all liability in respect of it.

26A Arbitration deemed to be legal proceedings

(1) In section 26(b) “legal proceedings” shall be deemed to include
arbitration.
(2) For the purposes of section 26, as affected by subsection (1), an
arbitration shall be deemed to be commenced when one party to the submission
serves on the other party or parties a notice requiring him or them to appoint an
arbitrator, or, where the submission provides that the reference shall be to a person
named or designated in the submission, requiring him or them to submit the
dispute to the person so named or designated.
(3) Any such notice as is mentioned in subsection (2) may be served either –
(a) By delivering it to the person on whom it is to be served; or
(b) By leaving it at the usual or last known place of abode in Niue of
that person; or
(c) By sending it by post in a registered letter addressed to that person
at his usual or last known place of abode in Niue,
as well as in any other manner provided in the submission; and where a notice is
sent by post in manner prescribed by paragraph (c) service of it shall, unless the
contrary is proved, be deemed to have been effected at the time at which the letter
would have been delivered in the ordinary course of post.

27 After 90 days warehouse owner may sell goods by public auction

If the lien is not discharged and no deposit is made as earlier mentioned,
the wharf or warehouse owner may, and if required by the shipowner shall, at the
expiry of 90 days from the time when the goods were placed in his custody, or, if
the goods are of a perishable nature, at such earlier period as may be fixed by
Lloyd’s Agent or any surveyor to be appointed by such wharf or warehouse owner,
sell by public auction either for home use or exportation, the said goods, or so
much of it as may be necessary to satisfy the charges earlier mentioned.

28 Notices of sale to be given

(1) Before making such sale the wharf or warehouse owner shall give notice
of it by advertisement in one newspaper circulating in the neighbourhood, a copy
of which shall be kept posted up in some conspicuous part of the said wharf or
warehouse.

Mercantile Law Act 1908

1067
(2) If the address of the owner of the goods has been stated on the manifest of the cargo, or on any of the documents in the possession of the wharf or warehouse owner, or is otherwise known to him, such wharf or warehouse owner shall give notice of the sale to the owner of the goods by letter sent by post.
(3) But the title of a bona fide purchaser of such goods shall not be invalidated by reason of the omission to send notice as earlier mentioned, nor shall any such purchaser be bound to inquire whether such notice has been sent.

29 Moneys arising from sale, how to be applied

In every case of any such sale as aforesaid the wharf or warehouse owner
shall apply the moneys received from the sale in the following order:
(a) If the goods are sold for home use, in payment of any Customs or
excise duties owing in respect thereof;
(b) In payment of the expenses of the sale;
(c) In the absence of any agreement between the wharf or warehouse
owner and the shipowner concerning the priority of their respective
charges, in payment of the rent, rates, and other charges due to the
wharf or warehouse owner in respect of the said goods;
(d) In payment of the amount claimed by the shipowner as due for
freight or other charges in respect of the said goods;
(e) But in the case of any agreement between the wharf or warehouse
owner and the shipowner concerning the priority of their respective
charges, then such charges shall have priority according to the terms
of such agreement; and
(f) The surplus, if any shall be paid to the owner of the goods.

30 Warehouse owner’s rent and expenses

Where goods are placed in the custody of a wharf or warehouse owner
under the authority of this Part, the said owner shall be entitled to rent in respect
of the same, and shall also have power at the expense of the owner of the goods to
do all such reasonable acts as in the judgment of the said wharf or warehouse
owner are necessary for the proper custody and preservation of such goods, and
shall have a lien on it for the said rent and expenses.

31 Warehouse owner’s protection

Nothing in this Part shall compel any wharf or warehouse owner to take
charge of any goods which he would not be liable to take charge of if this Part has
not passed, nor shall he be bound to see to the validity of any lien claimed by any
shipowner under this Part.
PART 5
UNPAID VENDORS OF WAREHOUSED GOODS

32 Interpretation

In this Part –
“bonded warehouse” means a building approved and appointed by the
Minister of Customs for the warehousing of goods without payment of
duty on the first entry;
“free warehouse” means a building licensed by the Minister of Customs
to be used exclusively for the storage of any goods not liable to the
payment of the Customs duties, or whereon such duties have been paid
previously to storage;
“goods” includes wares and merchandise or every description;
1068 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“pledge” means any deposit and delivery of warrants or certificates with intent that the holder of it may dispose to the goods to which such warrants or certificates relate in the event of the terms of the deposit not being fulfilled by the persons making the same;
“pledgee” means the person in whose favour the deposit or the warrants or certificates is made:
“sale” means–any absolute disposition of goods, whether for payment to be made in cash or upon credit;
“subpurchaser” means any person purchasing from or under the person
to whom the original bonder or storer of goods in a bonded or free
warehouse sold the same and delivered the warrants or certificates
relating to it;
“warehouse keeper” means the person having the management of any
bonded or free warehouse, whether the warehouseman himself or a
person employed by him;
“warehouse keeper ’s book” means the book in which the warehouse keeper
enters a list of all goods received in and delivered out of the warehouse
managed by him;
“warehouseman” means the person for whose immediate benefit and under
whose control the storage of goods in a bonded or free warehouse is
carried on;
“warrants” or “certificates” means any receipt or undertaking issued by or
on behalf of the warehouseman, and signed by him or on his behalf,
acknowledging the receipt in a specified warehouse of goods to be held
on behalf of a person named and described, giving the particulars of
the goods stored, the marks or brands (if any) on it, the terms upon
which the goods are stored, and containing an undertaking on the part
of the warehouseman to deliver the same to the endorsee, holder, or
bearer of the warrant or certificate.

33 Unpaid vendor’s lien determined on delivery of bond warrants to bona fide holder for value

In all cases where warrants or certificates for goods liable to the payment of Customs duties are issued, importing a receipt of such goods by or on behalf of any bonded warehouseman and an undertaking to deliver the same to the holder of the warrants or certificates on presentation and demand, and on payment of the duties, rents, and charges lawfully demandable, and such warrants or certificates are delivered over on a sale of the goods by the person to whom the said warrants or certificates are issued by or on behalf of the warehouseman, the rights legal and equitable, of such person, as an unpaid vendor, to stop actual delivery of the goods comprised in and affected by such warrants or certificates shall be deemed at an end when such warrants or certificates are delivered over bona fide and for value, on either a sale or pledge of the said goods by any person purchasing from the original bonder of it.

34 Possession of warrants prima facie evidence of ownership

On a sale or pledge of goods stored in any bonded warehouse, the
possession of warrants or certificates importing a receipt and undertaking to deliver
as aforesaid shall be deemed prima facie evidence of the ownership of the holder of
the said warrants or certificates in the goods and merchandise affected by it.

Mercantile Law Act 1908

1069

35 Holder of warrant entitled to delivery

Any holder of a warrant or certificate importing the obligations mentioned
shall be entitled on request and on compliance with the terms of the contract
implied by such warrants or certificates between the warehouseman and the
original bonder of the goods, to have delivery of it, or to have his name entered
upon the books of the warehouse keeper as the owner of the said goods.

36 Registered holder of warrant deemed to be owner

Save in the event of fraud being proved in the procurement of the entry of
the name of the holder of the certificates or warrants in the warehouse keeper ’s
books, the person whose name is so entered shall be conclusively deemed the
then owner in possession of the said goods, subject to the provisions hereinafter
contained.

37 Lien of registered transferee of warrant determined on delivery of warrant

bona fide and for value

In the event of any transfer being entered in the books of the warehouse
keeper, and the then owner of bonded goods delivers over the warrants or
certificates relating to or affecting the same to any other person on a sale or pledge
of the said goods, and such warrants or certificates are afterwards delivered over

bona fide and for value to any subpurchaser or pledgee by the person receiving the

same from the owner whose name is entered as aforesaid, the rights legal and
equitable of the said owner as an unpaid vendor to stop the actual delivery of the
goods comprised in and affected by such warrants or certificates shall be deemed
at an end as from the time of the bona fide delivery of the warrants or certificates to
the first subpurchaser or pledgee for value.

38 Warrants of free goods put on the same footing as bond warrants

Where goods are stored in any free warehouse, and warrants or certificates,
importing on behalf of the warehouseman a receipt of the goods and an
undertaking to deliver the same on presentation and demand and on payment of
the rents and charges lawfully demandable, are delivered to and accepted by the
person originally warehousing such goods, the respective rights and liabilities of
the warehouseman and warehouse keeper, and of the persons to whom the said
warrants or certificates were originally issued, or are afterwards delivered or
redelivered upon a resale or pledge bona fide and for value of the goods, or in
whose name the ownership may be transferred in the books of the warehouse
keeper, or who afterwards acquires possession bona fide and for value of the said
warrants or certificates, shall be the same in all respects as is provided with regard
to goods liable to the payment of customs duties and stored in a bonded warehouse.

39 Provisions same in respect of bonded and free warehouses

The provisions herein relative to the rights of or incident to the ownership
of goods stored in a bonded warehouse shall be as applicable to the ownership of
goods stored in a free warehouse as if such provisions had been respectively
repeated and expressly applied thereto.
1070 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

40 Vendor’s lien not prejudiced save as against bona fide subpurchaser or pledgee for value

Nothing herein shall in any way prejudice the rights of an unpaid vendor of goods to stop delivery of it until payment of the price payable to him whenever such rights may be lawfully exercised without detriment or injury to any subpurchaser or pledgee bona fide and for value, or to the rights of any trustee in bankruptcy claiming under the purchaser from the unpaid vendor.

41 Goods not to be transferred in books of warehouseman except on production of warrant

(1) No entry shall be made in the books of any warehouseman or keeper of any bonded or free warehouse transferring the ownership or possession of any goods, unless the person applying for such entry to be made produces and delivers up the warrants or certificates originally issued.
(2) Thereupon the warehouseman or the keeper of his warehouse may
cancel the said warrants or certificates and issue others in lieu and such new
warrants or certificates may in like manner be cancelled and others issued in
substitution of it.

42 Special contracts restraining negotiability of warrants

(1) Notwithstanding anything herein the person originally storing goods
in any bonded or free warehouse, and the warehouseman thereof, may enter into
a special contract restraining the negotiability of the warrants or certificates issued
in respect of the said goods, or providing some special method of transfer of the
property in and possession of such goods.
(2) In every such case the terms of such special contract shall be
incorporated in and made to appear upon the face of the said warrants or
certificates, so that the holder of it may have his attention expressly directed to it.

43 Warehouseman’s lien not prejudiced by sale or transfer of goods

No transfer of the ownership or possession of the goods stored in any
bonded or free warehouse shall in any way prejudicially affect the lien or rights of
the warehouseman in respect of any rent or charges previously incurred or become
payable on account of the goods the ownership or possession whereof may be so
transferred as aforesaid.
PART 6
BOOK PURCHASERS PROTECTION

44 Validity of agreements for purchase of books

(1) Every agreement for the purchase of any book or part of a book, or of
engravings, lithographs, or pictures, or of any other like matter, whether illustrated
or not (“printed matter”), shall be absolutely void in every case where such printed
matter is not to be delivered to the purchaser at the date of such agreement in a
completed form, and so as to embrace the whole of the volumes or numbers of the
printed matter, unless the purchaser of such printed matter first signs an agreement
on a form in which, in red capital letters not less than great primer, the following
words and figures are printed – namely, “The total liability of the purchaser under
this agreement is [inserting the amount in similar printed letters and also printed
figures of like size]” and unless such form is printed or written in black, wholly or
partly, across and subsequent to the printing of such red letters and figures.

Mercantile Law Act 1908

1071
(2) The vendor of such printed matter, or his agent, shall at the time of signing of the agreement aforesaid also hand over to the purchaser a duplicate of the agreement, having printed on it in addition the words “Duplicate to be kept by purchaser”, and the name and address in full of the vendor; and the vendor shall not be entitled to recover under such agreement unless he produces an acknowledgement by the purchaser that he has received such duplicate of the agreement as aforesaid.
(3) In any action in any court on any contract for the purchase of such printed matter, the court may determine the value of the said printed matter, proof of which shall be on the vendor.

1072 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

1073

MERCHANDISE MARKS ACT 1954

1954/43 (NZ) – 15 July 1955

1

Short title

11

Forging trade mark

2

Interpretation

12

Advertisements and other applications of

marks and descriptions

Certain Goods to Bear Indication of Origin

3 Power to require indication of origin General

4

Imported goods bearing name or trade

13

Exemption of employees in certain cases

mark of Niue manufacturer or trader not

to be sold unless accompanied by

14

Power of employer to exempt himself from

penalty on conviction of actual offender

indication of origin

15

Description of trade mark in pleading

5

[Repealed]

16

Punishment of accessories

6

Penalty on removal of any required mark

17

Limitation of prosecution

from goods

18

General penalty for offences

7

Offences arising from failure to mark

19

Forfeiture

8

Special provisions in respect of blends and

20

Implied warranty on sale of marked goods

mixtures

21

Provisions as to false description not to

apply in certain cases

False Trade Descriptions

22

Importation of certain goods prohibited

9

Offences as to trade marks and trade

23

[Spent]

descriptions

24

Savings in respect of liabilities

10

Application of false trade description

25

[Spent]

To consolidate and amend certain enactments relating to merchandise marks

1 Short title

This is the Merchandise Marks Act 1954.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act and in any regulation made under this Act–
“advertisement” means any words, whether written or spoken, or any
picture, drawing, or figure –
(a) Inserted in any newspaper or other periodical publication printed
and published in Niue; or
(b) Brought to the notice of members of public in Niue in other manner
whatsoever;
“certification trademark” includes any mark which is used or on in
connection with goods for the purpose of indicating that they are the
goods of the proprietor of the mark by virtue of certification;
“covering” includes any stopper, cask, bottle, vessel, box, cover, capsule,
case, frame, or wrapper;
“dealer” includes any servant or employee of a dealer;
1074 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
“false trade description” means a trade description which is false or misleading in a material respect as regards the goods to which it is applied; and includes every alteration of trade description, whether by way of addition, effacement, or otherwise where that alteration makes the description false or misleading in a material respect; and also includes a trade description (to whichever of the matters mentioned in the definition of that term in this section it relates) if it is likely to be misunderstood as, or mistaken for, an indication of the same or some other such matter which would be false or misleading in a material respect as regards the goods to which the description is applied; and the fact that a trade description is a trade mark or part of a trade mark shall not prevent the trade description being a false trade description within the meaning of this Act; but no trade mark or part of a trade mark shall be treated as a false description in relation to any goods to which the trade mark or part of a trade mark is applied if the following conditions are satisfied.
(a) On the day this Act is passed the trade mark either is registered under the Trade Marks Act 1953 (NZ) or is in use to indicate a connection in the course of trade between those goods and the proprietor of the trade mark; and
(b) The trade mark as applied is used to indicate connection in the
course of trade between the goods and the person who is the
proprietor of the trade mark or between the goods and a person
who is registered under section 37 of the Trade Marks Act 1953
(NZ) as a registered user of the trade mark; and
(c) The person who is the proprietor of the trade mark is the same
person as, or a successor in title to, the proprietor of the day this
Act is passed;
“goods” means anything which is subject of trade, manufacture, or
merchandise;
“imported goods” does not include –
(a) Goods which since the date of their importation have undergone
in Niue any treatment or process resulting in a substantial change
in the goods; or
(b) Goods produced or manufactured in Niue which after exportation
are brought back into Niue including any such goods which have
undergone abroad any treatment or process not resulting in a
substantial change in the goods;
“indication of origin” in relation to any goods, means a definite, clear,
conspicuous indication in the English language of the country in which
the goods were manufactured or produced;
“label” includes any band or ticket;
“manufacturer” includes any servant or employee of a manufacturer;
“mark” includes a device, brand, heading, label, ticket, name, signature,
word, letter, numeral, or any combination thereof;
“name” includes any abbreviation of a name;
“person” includes any servant or employee of a person;
“proprietor” includes any servant or employee of a proprietor;
“sale” –
(a) Includes, subject as hereinafter provided, sale wholesale as well as
sale by retail:
Provided that references to exposure for sale in sections 4 and 7 of

Merchandise Marks Act 1954

1075
this Act or (unless the order expressly provides to the contrary) in any regulations made under this Act shall not include exposure for sale wholesale by a person being a wholesale dealer;
(b) Does not include –
(i) a sale of goods for consignment by the vendor to a person
outside Niue; or
(ii) a sale of second hand goods; or
(iii) the sale of any foodstuffs at any hotel or restaurant or other
premises for consumption thereon or the sale of any foodstuffs
which have undergone a process of cooking, curing, or
preserving in Niue;
“trade description” –
(a) Means any description, statement, or other indication, direct or
indirect, –
(i) as to the number, quantity, measure, gauge, or weight of any
goods; or
(ii) as to the standard of quality of any goods according to a
classification commonly used or recognised in the trade; or
(iii) as to the place or country in which any goods and the material
or substance of it were made or produced; or
(iv) as to the mode of manufacturing or producing any goods; or
(v) as to the material or substance of which any goods are
composed; or
(vi) as to any goods being the subject of an existing patent, privilege,
or copyright; and
(b) Includes –
(i) the use of any figure, word, or mark which according to the
custom of the trade is commonly taken to be an indication of
any of those matters; and
(ii) anything likely to be misunderstood as or mistaken for an
indication of any of those matters;
“trade mark” means any trade mark within the meaning of the Trade Marks
Act 1953 (NZ); and includes a certification trade mark, and any mark
which is used upon or in connection with goods for the purpose of
indicating that they are the goods of the proprietor of the mark by virtue
of manufacture, selection, certification, dealing with, or offering for sale;
“trader” includes any servant or employee of a trader.
(2) For the purposes of this Act goods shall be deemed to be manufactured
or made in any place if they have undergone in that place any treatment or process
resulting in substantial change in the goods.

Certain Goods to Bear Indication of Origin

3 Power to require indication of origin

(1) Cabinet may by regulation –
(a) Direct that goods of any class or description specified in the order
shall, in the case of goods intended for importation into Niue at the
time of their importation or exposure for sale in Niue, or in the case
of goods manufactured in Niue at the time of their manufacture or
exposure for sale in Niue, bear an indication of origin;
(b) Prohibit the sale or the exposure for sale in Niue of goods of any
class or description specified in the regulation unless they bear an
indication of origin;
1076 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(c) Exclude specified items from any class or description of goods. (2) A regulation under this section shall specify in every case –
(a) The manner in which the indication of origin is to be applied to the goods; and
(b) The date on which the regulation is to come into force (not being a date earlier than 3 months from the date of the making of the regulation, except in the case of a regulation revoking a previous regulation either entirely or as respects some of the goods to which that regulation relates, or a regulation made for amending a previous regulation in consequence of a direction having been given with respect to that regulation under this section relating to provisional exemptions); and
(c) Whether the goods are to bear the indication of origin at the time of importation or of manufacture or of exposure for sale wholesale.
(3) If, where regulations have been made under this Act with respect to
any goods, it is shown to the satisfaction of the Minister by persons appearing to
him to have a substantial interest in the matter that the application of the provisions
of the regulation or of some of those provisions, to any particular class or
description of those goods has caused, or is likely to cause, injury or hardship to
the said persons, or any of them, the Minister may, by notice in the Gazette, direct
that the regulation, or any particular provisions of the regulation shall cease to
apply to goods of that class or description or shall apply to those goods subject
only to such modifications and conditions as the Minister thinks fit, and the
regulation shall, while the direction is in force, have effect subject to it.

4 Imported goods bearing name or trade mark of Niue manufacturer or trader not to be sold unless accompanied by indication of origin

(1) It shall not be lawful to sell, expose for sale, or (by way of advertising goods of some kind) distribute, in Niue any imported goods to which there is applied any name or trade mark or words, being or purporting to be the name or trade mark of any manufacturer, dealer, or trader in Niue or the name of any place or district in Niue or words which would be likely to associate the goods with Niue unless the name, mark, or words are accompanied by and indication of origin.
(2) If the Minister is satisfied, after considering such representations (if
any) as may be made to him by any persons appearing to have a substantial interest
in the matter, that having regard to the special circumstances of the trade, difficulties
would arise if this section applied to goods of any class or description, or goods
sold under any particular designation, and that public interests in Niue would
not be materially prejudiced by exempting the goods from the operation of this
section, he may, by notice in the Gazette, direct that this section shall not apply to
those goods, or that goods shall not be treated as falling under this section by
reason only that they are so designated.
(3) This section shall not have effect in respect of the application of a name
or trade mark to articles used or to be used for any of the following purposes as
coverings, labels, reels, or otherwise as articles in or with which goods
manufactured or produced in Niue or are to be sold or exposed for sale, if –
(a) The name or trade mark so applied is the name or trade mark of a
manufacturer of or a dealer or a trader in those goods in Niue and
the name or trade mark was applied with his consent;

Merchandise Marks Act 1954

1077
(b) The trade mark is a certification trade mark and it relates or is to relate to those goods, and was so applied by or with the consent of the proprietor of the certification trade mark or by another in accordance with his authorisation under the regulations relating to the certification trade mark.

5 [Repealed by 2004/270]

6 Penalty on removal of any required mark from goods

If any person removes, alters, or obliterates an indication of origin which,
in compliance with the requirements of section 4 or a regulation made under section
3, was borne by the goods at the time of their importation or exposure for sale
wholesale, he shall be deemed to have acted in contravention of that provision or
regulation unless he proves to the satisfaction of the court dealing with the case
that the removal, alteration, or obliteration was not for the purpose of concealing
the origin of the goods at the time of their sale or exposure for sale.

7 Offences arising from failure to mark

(1) Subject to this section, every person who sells, exposes for sale, or
distributes by way of advertisement, any goods in contravention of the foregoing
provisions of this Act, or acts in contravention of or fails to comply with any such
provision or any regulation made under section 3, commits an offence and shall
be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit; and the Court may
in the case of a second or subsequent offence also order the goods in relation to
which the offence has been committed to be forfeited.
(2) (a) If any person advertises or offers for sale as being goods of a
particular brand or make or otherwise under a specific designation,
by means of an illustration or by means of any written matter, any
goods of a class or description which are required by any regulation
under section 3 to bear an indication of origin, he shall, if he does
not include in the advertisement or offer an indication of the origin
of the goods, and subject to this section, be deemed to have acted in
contravention of a regulation made under that section.
(b) This subsection shall not apply in the case of any advertisement
made, issued or published before the date on which the regulation
was made.
(3) Where any person sells, or exposes for sale, any goods, of which some
(being goods to which a regulation under section 3 applies) form a distinguishable
part, and that part is reasonably capable of having applied to it an indication of
origin in manner required by the regulation he shall, for the purposes of this section,
be deemed to have sold, or exposed for sale, that part, and the provisions of this
section shall apply accordingly.
(4) It shall not within Niue be lawful to sell or offer for sale by sample
goods of a class or description to which a regulation under section 3 applies unless
the required indication of origin is applied to the samples or unless particulars
corresponding to the particulars which would be contained in such an indication
are communicated in writing to the person whom the samples are submitted, and
if any person acts in contravention of this subsection he shall, subject to this section,
be deemed to have acted in contravention of a regulation made under section 3.
1078 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(5) A person shall not be guilty of an offence if he proves –
(a) That having taken all reasonable precautions against committing
such an offence he had at the time of the commission of the alleged
offence no reason to suspect that the goods were goods to which
the foregoing provisions of this Act or regulation made under section
3 applied, and that on a demand made by or on behalf of the
prosecutor he gave all the information in his power with respect to
the persons from whom he obtained the goods; or
(b) That otherwise he had acted innocently.

8 Special provisions in respect of blends and mixtures

(1) Section 4 shall not extend to blends or mixtures, and regulations made
under section 3 with respect to goods of any class or description shall not extend
to blends or mixtures consisting of or containing those goods unless the regulation
expressly so provides, and, where any regulation so provides, the indication of
origin to be given in respect of the blends or mixtures shall, notwithstanding
anything in this Act, be an indication in such form as the regulation prescribes.
(2) The provisions of this section shall not apply to any blend or mixture
produced by a process of manufacture from materials of different kinds.

False Trade Descriptions

9 Offences as to trade marks and trade descriptions

(1) Subject to this Act, and unless he proves that he acted without intent to
defraud, every person commits an offence who –
(a) Forges any trade mark; or
(b) Falsely applies to goods any trade mark or any mark so nearly
resembling a trade mark as to be likely to deceive; or
(c) Makes any dye, block, machine, or other instrument for the purpose
of forging or of being used for forging a trade mark; or
(d) Applies any false trade description to goods; or
(e) Disposes of or has in his possession any dye, block, machine, or
other instrument for the purpose of forging a trade mark; or
(f) Falsely represents that goods offered for sale were manufactured
or made in Niue; or
(g) Uses any word, mark, or sign likely to mislead any person as to the
real or actual manufacturer or maker of goods, or the place where
the goods were made or manufactured; or
(h) Causes any of the things specified in this subsection to be done.
(2) Every person commits an offence who sells, or exposes, or has in his
possession for any purpose of trade or manufacture, any goods or things to which
any forged trade mark or false trade description is applied, or to which any trade
mark or mark so nearly resembling a trade mark as to be likely to deceive is falsely
applied unless he proves –
(a) That, having taken all reasonable precautions against committing
an offence against this Act, he had at the time of the commission of
the alleged offence no reason to suspect the genuineness of the trade
mark, mark, or trade description; and that, on demand made by or
on behalf of the prosecutor, he gave all the information in his power
with respect to the persons from whom he obtained the goods or
things; or
(b) That otherwise he acted innocently.

Merchandise Marks Act 1954

1079

10 Application of false trade description

(1) The provisions of this Act relating to the application of a false trade
description to goods shall extend to the application to goods of any such figures,
words, or marks, or arrangement or combination of it, whether including a trade
mark or not as are likely to lead persons to believe that the goods are the
manufacture or merchandise of some person other than the person whose
manufacture or merchandise they really are.
(2) The provisions of this Act relating to the application of false trade
description to goods, or respecting goods to which a false trade description is
applied, shall extend to the application of goods of any false name or initials of a
person and to goods with the false name of initials of a person applied, in like
manner as if the name or initials were a trade description; and for the purpose of
this enactment the expression “false name or initials” means, as applied to any
goods, any name or initials of a person which –
(a) Are not a trade mark or part of a trade mark; and
(b) Are identical with or a colourable imitation of the name or initials
of a person who carries on business in connection with goods of
the same description, and who has not authorised the use of the
name or initials; and
(c) Are either those of a fictitious person or of some person not carrying
on business in connection with the goods.

11 Forging trade mark

(1) A person shall be deemed to forge a trade mark who –
(a) Without the assent of the proprietor of the trade mark, makes that
trade mark or a mark so nearly resembling that trade mark as to be
likely to deceive; or
(b) Falsifies any genuine trade mark, whether by alteration, addition,
effacement, or otherwise.
(2) Any trade mark or mark so made or falsified is in this Act referred to as
a forged trade mark.
(3) In any prosecution for forging a trade mark the burden of proving the
assent of the proprietor shall lie on the defendant.

12 Advertisements and other applications of marks and descriptions

(1) A person shall be deemed to apply a trade mark, mark, or trade
description to goods who –
(a) Applies it to the goods themselves; or
(b) Applies it to any covering, label, reel, or other thing in or with which
the goods are sold or exposed or had in possession for any purpose
of sale, trade, or manufacture; or
(c) Places, encloses, or annexes any goods which are sold or exposed
or had in possession for any purpose of sale, trade, or manufacture
in , with, or to any covering, label, reel, or other thing to which that
trade mark, mark or trade description has been applied; or
(d) Uses a trade mark, or mark, or trade description in any manner
likely to lead to the belief that the goods in connection with which
it is used are designated or described by that trade mark, mark, or
trade description.
(2) A trade mark, mark or trade description shall be deemed to be applied
to goods whether it is woven or impressed or otherwise worked into, or annexed,
or affixed to the goods, or to any covering, label, reel, or other thing in or with the
goods.
1080 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) A person shall be deemed falsely to apply to goods a trade mark or mark who, without the assent of the proprietor, applies that trade mark or mark, or one so nearly resembling it as to be likely to deceive; and in any prosecution for falsely applying a trade mark or mark to goods the burden of proving the assent of the proprietor shall lie on the defendant.
(4) For the purposes of subsection (1)(d) goods delivered under a request
made by reference to a trade mark or mark or trade description appearing in any
sign, advertisement, invoice, wine list, business letter, business paper, or other
commercial communication shall be deemed to be goods in connection with which
the trade mark, mark or trade description is used.

General

13 Exemption of employees in certain cases

(1) Where a defendant is charged with making any dye, block, machine,
or other instrument for the purpose of forging or being used for forging a trade
mark or with falsely applying to goods any trade mark or any mark so nearly
resembling a trade mark as to be likely to deceive, or with applying to goods any
false trade description, or causing any of the things in this section mentioned to
be done, and proves –
(a) That in the ordinary course of his business he is employed on behalf
of other persons to make dyes, blocks, machines, or other
instruments for making or being used in making trade marks, or
for applying marks of descriptions to goods, and that in the case
which is the subject of the charge he was so employed by some
person resident in Niue, and was not interested in the goods by
way of profit or commission dependent on the sale of goods; and
(b) That he took reasonable precautions against committing the offence
charged; and
(c) That he had at the time of the commission of the alleged offence no
reason to suspect the genuineness of the trade mark, mark or trade
description; and
(d) That he gave to the prosecutor all the information in his power
with respect to the persons on whose behalf the trade mark, mark
or trade description was applied –
he shall be discharged from the prosecution, but shall be liable to pay the costs
incurred by the prosecutor, unless he has given due notice to him that he will rely
on the above defence.
(2) Nothing in this Act shall be construed so as to render liable to any
prosecution of punishment any servant of a master resident in Niue who acts in
good faith in obedience to the instructions of that master, and, on demand made
by or on behalf of the prosecutor, has given full information as to his master.

14 Power of employer to exempt himself from penalty on conviction of actual offender

(1) Where an employer or principal is charged with the offence of having acted in contravention of, or of having failed to comply with any provision of this Act or any regulation made under this Act he shall be entitled on information duly laid by him and on giving not less than 3 days’ notice of his intention to the prosecution to have any other person whom he charges as the actual offender brought before the court at the time appointed for hearing the charge, and if, after the commission of the offence has been proved, the employer or principal proves to the satisfaction of the court that he has used due diligence to enforce compliance

Merchandise Marks Act 1954

1081
with this Act or of the regulation, and that the said other person had committed the offence in question without his consent, connivance, or wilful default, the said other person shall, subject to section 7 (5), be convicted of the offence, and the employer or principal shall be exempt from any penalty.
(2) The person so convicted shall, in the discretion of the court, be also liable to pay any costs incidental to proceedings.
(3) The prosecution shall in any such case have the right to cross-examine the employer or principal if he gives evidence, and any witnesses called by him in support of his charge, and to call rebutting evidence.

15 Description of trade mark in pleading

In any indictment, pleading, proceeding, or document in which any trade
mark or forged trade mark is intended to be mentioned it shall be sufficient, without
further description and without any copy or facsimile, to state that mark or forged
mark to be a trade mark or forged trade mark.

16 Punishment of accessories

Every person who being in Niue procures, counsels, aids, abets, or is
accessory to the commission out of Niue of any act which if committed in Niue
would under this Act be an offence punishable on indictment shall be guilty of
that offence as a principal, and be liable to be indicted, proceeded against, tried,
and convicted in Niue as if the offence had been committed there.

17 Limitation of prosecution

No prosecution for an offence against this Act shall be commenced after
the expiration of 3 years from the date of the commission of the offence, or after
the expiration of one year from the first discovery of it by the prosecutor, whichever
first happens.

18 General penalty for offences

Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no penalty
is provided elsewhere than in this section shall be liable on conviction –
(a) To imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or to a fine not
exceeding 10 penalty units, or to both such imprisonment and such
fine; and
(b) If the court so directs, to forfeit to the Government every chattel,
article, instrument, or thing, by means of or in relation to which the
offence was committed.

19 Forfeiture

(1) Where any articles (including goods, chattels, instruments, and things)
would be liable to forfeiture under section 7 if the owner was convicted of a second
offence against this Act, or under section 18 if the owner was convicted of an
offence against this Act, and the owner is unknown or cannot be found, an
application to the Court may be made for the purpose only of enforcing the
forfeiture, and any Judge may cause notice to be advertised stating that, unless
cause is shown to the contrary at the time and place specified in the notice, the
articles will be forfeited; and at that time and place any Judge, unless the owner or
any person on his behalf or other person interested in the articles shows cause to
the contrary, may order the articles or any of them to be forfeited.
(2) Subject to this section and to any directions of the Court which orders
the forfeiture, any such articles which are forfeited under this Act may be sold,
destroyed, or otherwise disposed of as the Minister may direct.
1082 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) Subject to subsection (4)(6), where any such articles which are forfeited under this Act are sold, the proceeds of sale shall be applied in the like manner as if the proceeds were a fine incurred under this Act.
(4) Where any such articles are forfeited under this Act, or under the
Customs Act 1966 in consequence of the operation of section 22 of this Act –
(a) If the articles are not destroyed, all trade marks or trade descriptions
which are on the articles in contravention of this Act or of any
regulation made under section 3 shall be obliterated before the
articles are sold or otherwise disposed of;
(b) If the Court which orders the forfeiture or any Judge so directs, any
innocent party may be reimbursed out of the proceeds of any such
sale or disposition any loss he may have innocently sustained in
dealing with the articles.
(5) Any such direction may be given by the court which order the forfeiture
at the time when it is ordering the forfeiture, or by any Judge on an application
made to the High Court in that behalf by any interested person.

20 Implied warranty on sale of marked goods

On the sale or in the contract for the sale of any goods to which a trade
mark, mark or trade description has been applied, the vendor shall be deemed to
warrant that the trade mark or mark is a genuine one and not forged or falsely
applied, and that the trade description is not a false trade description within the
meaning of this Act, unless the contrary is expressed in some writing signed by or
on behalf of the vendor and delivered at the time of the sale or contract to and
accepted by the purchaser.

21 Provisions as to false description not to apply in certain cases

(1) Where on the coming into operation of this Act a trade description was
lawfully and generally applied to goods of a particular class or manufactured by
a particular method, to indicate the particular class or method of manufacture of
the goods, the provisions of this Act with respect to false trade descriptions shall
not apply to that trade description when so applied.
(2) Where the trade description includes the name of a place or country,
and is calculated to mislead as to the place or country where the goods to which it
is applied were actually made or produced, and the goods were not actually made
or produced in that place or country, this section shall not apply unless there is
added to the trade description immediately before or after the name of that place
or country, in an equally conspicuous manner with that name, the name of the
place or country in which the goods and the material or substance of it were actually
made or produced, with a statement that they were made or produced there.

22 Importation of certain goods prohibited

All goods which if exposed for sale in Niue would be liable to forfeiture
under section 18(1)(b) are hereby prohibited to be imported into Niue, and shall
be deemed to be included among goods prohibited to be imported under section
48 of the Customs Act 1966, subject to the following provisions, that is to say:
(a) Before detaining any such goods, or taking any further proceeding
with a view to their forfeiture under the Customs Act 1966, the
Minister of Customs may require the regulations under this section,
whether as to information, security, conditions, or other matters, to
be complied with, and may satisfy himself, in accordance with those
regulations, that the goods are such as are prohibited by this section
to be imported;

Merchandise Marks Act 1954

1083
(b) Section 19(4) shall apply in connection with any such goods which are forfeited under the Customs Act 1966;
(c) Cabinet may make regulations, either general or special, respecting the detention and forfeiture of goods that importation of which is prohibited by this section, and the conditions, if any, to be fulfilled before such detention and forfeiture, and may by any such regulations determine the information, notices, and security to be given, and the evidence requisite for any of the purposes of this section, and the mode of verifying any such evidence;
(d) Regulations so made may apply to all goods the importation of which is prohibited by this section, or to any class or classes of those goods or of offences in relation to those goods;
(e) Regulations so made may provide that the informant shall reimburse the Minister of Customs all expenses and damages incurred in respect of any detention made on his information, and of any proceedings consequent on such detention.

23 [Spent]

24 Savings in respect of liabilities

(1) This Act shall not exempt any person from any action, suit, or other
proceeding which might, but for the provisions of this Act, be brought against
him.
(2) Nothing in this Act shall entitle any person to refuse to make a complete discovery or to answer any question or interrogatory in any action, but such discovery or answer shall not be admissible in evidence, against that person in any prosecution of an offence against this Act.

25 [Spent]

1084 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1085

MINING ACT 1977

1977/30 – 5 August 1977

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

1

Short title

2

Interpretation

3

Minerals property of Crown

4

Atomic Energy Act 1945

PART 2

ADMINISTRATION

5

Mining Inspectors

6

Duties of Mining Inspectors

7

Failure to comply with directions

8

Special powers of Mining Inspectors

9

Obstruction prohibited

10

Mining Office

11

Office of miner

PART 3

ACQUISITION OF LAND

12

Acquisition of Niuean Land

13

Crown land open for mining

14

Niuean land open for mining

15

Niuean land may be declared open for

mining without consent of owner

16

Agreement with owner for mining

17

Area of mining lease

PART 4

GRANT OF LICENCES

18

Prospecting licences

19

Mining licences

20

Access licence

21

Form of licence

22

Validity of licence

23

Licence deemed to have been confirmed

24

Registration of licence


1086 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

To make provision for mining for minerals in Niue, and for incidental or connected matters

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Mining Act 1977.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“access licence” means any licence granted under section 20;
“alienation” means alienation as defined in section 2 of the Niue
Amendment (No 2) Act 1968;
“Chief Mining Inspector” means the Chief Mining Inspector appointed
under section 5;
“Crown land” means Crown land as defined in section 2 of the Niue
Amendment (No 2) Act 1968;
“licence” means any access licence, mining licence or prospecting licence;
“mine” means any mine, quarry, tunnel, excavation, working or any other
place where any mining is being carried on or has been carried out;
“miner” means any person, including a body corporate holding a valid
and subsisting mining licence;
“minerals” means all minerals, mineral substances, gold, silver, precious
metals, ferrous metals, non-ferrous metals, bauxite, phosphate,
phosphate rock, diatomaceous earth, marble, coal, bitumen, lignite,
precious stones, and petroleum existing in their natural state on or under
the surface of any land, and includes any prescribed substance within
the meaning of the Atomic Energy Act 1945, but does not include any
coral, common clay, common sand, common gravel, common stone or
common earth;
“mining” means mining operations;
“Mining Inspector” means:
(a) The Chief Mining Inspector; or
(b) A Mining Inspector duly appointed and holding office, under this
Act, as a Mining Inspector;
“mining licence” means a mining licence issued under this Act;
“mining operations” and “mining purposes” means operations in
connection with mining for any mineral, and includes –
(a) The removal of overburden by mechanical or other means, and the
stacking, deposit, storage, and treatment of any substance
considered to contain any mineral;
(b) The deposit or discharge of any mineral, material, debris, tailings,
refuse, or waste-water produced from, or consequent on, any such
operations or purposes;
(c) The erection, maintenance, and use of plant and machinery, and
the construction or use of roads, races, dams, railways, channels,
batteries, buildings, dwellings, and other works connected with
such operations or purposes; and
(d) The lawful use of land, water, pools and natural depositories of
water (whether containing water or not) and the doing of all lawful
acts incidental or conducive to any such operations or purposes;

Mining Act 1977 1087

“Niuean land” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Niue Amendment
(No 2) Act 1968;
“prescribed substances” means uranium, thorium, plutonium, neptunium,
or any of their respective compounds, or any such other substance as
Cabinet may prescribe by notice in the Gazette, being a substance which
in its opinion is or may be used for the production of atomic energy or
research into matters connected with it;
“prospecting” means searching for minerals in the soil or substrata of any
land to assess whether the soil or substrata is suitable for the mining of
any mineral, or to test the mineral bearing qualities of any soil or
substrata, but does not include mining;
“prospecting licence” means a prospecting licence issued under section
18;
“prospector” means any person holding a valid and subsisting prospecting
licence;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of the Court.

3 Minerals property of Crown

(1) All minerals on or under the surface of any land (including the seabed)
within the territorial limits of Niue, are declared to be the property of the Crown.
(2) All grants of Crown land and all alienations of Niuean land shall be
deemed to be made subject to the reservation to the Crown of all minerals on or
under the surface of the land.

4 Atomic Energy Act 1945

Nothing in this Act shall affect or derogate from the Atomic Energy Act
1945 or be deemed to affect or derogate from its provisions, and should there be
any conflict between that Act and this Act, that Act shall prevail.

5 Mining Inspectors

PART 2
ADMINISTRATION
(1) There may be appointed, under Part 6 of the Constitution a Chief Mining Inspector and such number of other Mining Inspectors as may be required for the purpose of this Act.
(2) The Chief Mining Inspector shall have all the powers of and be deemed to be a Mining Inspector.

6 Duties of Mining Inspectors

It shall be the duty and function of a Mining Inspector –
(a) To inspect mines;
(b) When he has reason to believe that any mining or other operation
or activity being carried on at any mine, or that the state or condition
of any mine, constitutes a hazard or danger to any person, livestock
or building, to give to any miner or to the duly authorised agent or
servant of the miner, or to any person engaged in mining at the
mine, reasonable directions for, or with a view to, removing,
preventing or alleviating the hazard or danger; and
(c) To ensure that the provisions of this Act are duly observed.
1088 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

7 Failure to comply with directions

Where any miner, or the duly authorised agent or servant of any miner, or
any person engaged in mining to whom any directions are given under section
6(b) knowingly and wilfully fails to comply with the directions, he commits an
offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 months or, where the offender is a
body corporate, to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

8 Special powers of Mining Inspectors

(1) A Mining Inspector may in the exercise of duties, functions or powers
under this Act enter any mine or any place where minerals obtained by mining
are stored or kept, or any place where he has reason to believe that any such
minerals, are or may be stored or kept.
(2) Save with the prior written consent of a Judge or of a Commissioner, a
Mining Inspector shall not exercise any of the powers conferred by this subsection –
(a) At any time between the hours of sunset and sunrise; or
(b) In or upon any private dwelling or private garden, except with the
permission of the occupier.
(3) A Mining Inspector may take and retain on behalf of the Crown from
any mine or any place where minerals that are obtained, or apparently obtained,
by mining are stored or kept, reasonable samples of any minerals, soil or earth.

9 Obstruction prohibited

(1) Any person who obstructs, hinders, disobeys, assaults, threatens, or
abuses any Mining Inspector while the Inspector is performing any duty, exercising
any power or carrying out any function imposed or conferred upon the Inspector
by this Act, commits an offence, and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 1 penalty unit or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 1 month, or,
where the person is a body corporate, to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.
(2) Nothing in this section shall derogate from section 7.

10 Mining Office

(1) There shall be a Mining Office which shall be situated in Alofi at such
place as Cabinet shall specify.
(2) The Mining Office shall be under the control of the Chief Mining
Inspector.
(3) At the Mining Office there shall be kept copies of all licences, documents,
notices and other writings and instruments issued under this Act, which shall
comprise the public records or the Mining Office.
(4) The public records of the Mining Office shall be open to inspection,
without fee, by members of the public on any day except a Saturday, or a holiday
at all reasonable hours fixed by the Chief Mining Inspector.
(5) (a) None of the public records of the Mining Office shall, without the
prior consent of the Cabinet, or a Judge or Commissioner of the
Court, or the Chief Mining Inspector be removed from the Mining
Office.
(b) Any such Judge or Commissioner may order the Chief Mining
Inspector to cause any of such public records to be produced in any
court.
(6) Any person who knowingly and wilfully removes any of such public
records, contrary to subsection (5) from the Mining Office, commits an offence
and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit, or to

Mining Act 1977 1089

imprisonment for a term not exceeding one month or, if the removal was made with any fraudulent or other dishonest intent, to a fine not exceeding 3 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 9 months.

11 Office of miner

(1) Every miner shall have, in Niue, an office and shall, in writing, inform
the Chief Mining Inspector at the Mining Office of the location of that office or
any change in the location of that office.
(2) Any miner who, for more than 7 clear days, is in breach of subsection
(1) commits an offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding
0.5 penalty units.
(3) Any notice or other document which any person may wish to serve
upon or deliver to any miner shall be deemed to have been validly served upon or
delivered to the miner if it be delivered at the office referred to in subsection (1) of
the miner as the same is recorded in the records of the Mining Office.
(4) Nothing in subsection (3) shall preclude the service or delivery of any
notice or other document in any manner sanctioned by law.
PART 3
ACQUISITION OF LAND

12 Acquisition of Niuean land

Cabinet shall have the authority to investigate and acquire Niuean land by
way of lease or purchase for the following purposes –
(a) For mining and for all purposes necessary effectually to carry on
mining operations in or on the land for any mineral;
(b) For cutting and constructing on the land water races, drains, dams,
and roads, to be used in connection with such mining;
(c) For the erection on it of any buildings and machinery to be used in
connection with any such mining;
(d) For boring, sinking for, pumping or raising water;
(e) For residence on it in connection with any or all such purposes.

13 Crown land open for mining

All Crown land shall be open for mining, subject to and in accordance with
this Act or regulations made under this Act.

14 Niuean land open for mining

Without limiting this Act, if minerals are discovered on or under Niuean
land, the land shall, with the written consent of the owner or occupier, be open for
mining, subject to and under this Act.

15 Niuean land may be declared open for mining without consent of owner

(1) If the owner or occupier of any Niuean land fails or refuses to consent
to the acquisition of land for mining, the Assembly may by resolution direct Cabinet
to declare the land to be open for mining as if it were Crown land.
(2) Where the Assembly resolution is passed under subsection (1) Cabinet
shall cause to be served on the owner or occupier of the land a notice in writing
stating that unless, within a period of 6 months after the date on which the notice
was served, the owner or occupier consents to the land being open for mining, the
land may be declared to be open for mining as if it were Crown land.
(3) No owner or occupier of land who has had served on him a notice
under subsection (2) shall, within the period of one year after the date of receipt of
1090 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
the notice, enter into any arrangement with any other person for the mining of any mineral on or under the land to which the notice relates.
(4) If satisfactory arrangements (including, if necessary, an agreement to grant a right of way) have not been made by the owner or the occupier within the period of 6 months referred to in subsection (2), Cabinet within 3 months after the expiry of the said period of 6 months, shall declare the land in respect of which the notice was served or any part of it to be open for mining if Cabinet considers it to be in the national interest to do so.
(5) Where any land is required under this section is proven by the owner
or occupier to be their only land that owner or that occupier shall be provided
with alternative land of an equal value at some other place in Niue.

16 Agreement with owner for mining

Instead of recommending that any land be declared to be open for mining under
section 15, Cabinet may agree in writing with the owner or occupier of the land
that it shall be open for mining in the same manner as Crown land.

17 Area of mining lease

(1) The area of any land comprised in a mining lease shall not exceed 40
acres and the length of the area, as far as practicable, shall not exceed twice its
width.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) shall restrict the area of land required for the purpose of mining for a prescribed substance within the meaning of the Atomic Energy Act 1945.

18 Prospecting licences

PART 4
GRANT OF LICENCES
(1) Cabinet shall have the authority to grant prospecting licences.
(2) Cabinet shall make regulations under this section to regulate the
granting of prospecting licences.

19 Mining licences

(1) Cabinet shall have the authority to grant mining licences under this
Act or under any regulations made under this Act.
(2) No person shall engage in mining in, upon or under any land unless,
in relation to that land, the person holds a mining licence issued to the person
under subsection (1).
(3) Any person who engages in mining contrary to subsection (2) commits
an offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine of 5 penalty units or to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 months or, where the person is a body
corporate, to a fine not exceeding 20 penalty units.
(4) Where any person is convicted of an offence contrary to subsection (2)
the Court may, on convicting or sentencing the person, make an order vesting in
the Crown all or any vehicles, machinery, equipment, tools or other things used
by the person in the commission or in furtherance of the offence and upon the
making of any such order, the vehicles, machinery, equipment, tools or other things
so vested shall be forfeited to and become the absolute property of the Crown and
shall be dealt with or disposed of in such manner as the Cabinet may direct.
(5) No person shall, as of right, be entitled to the grant of a mining licence.
(6) Subject to section 27, where, in respect of any piece or area of land,
there is in existence a subsisting mining licence, no mining licence shall be granted

Mining Act 1977 1091

in respect of the piece or area of land without first consulting the miner holding the subsisting licence.
(7) No mining licence shall be granted for a period in excess of 50 years commencing on the date of issue.

20 Access licence

(1) Where a miner is unable to obtain reasonable access to any area or piece
of land mentioned in the mining licence held by the miner, the miner may apply
in writing to Cabinet for a grant to the miner of an access licence to that area or
piece of land over any other area or piece of land to be specified in the licence.
(2) On the receipt of any such application and if Cabinet considers the
application to be reasonable in the circumstances, Cabinet shall grant the access
licence sought subject to any reasonable conditions that it may specify.
(3) Every access licence shall be effectual only during the subsistence of
the mining licence to which it relates.

21 Form of licence

(1) Every licence shall be in writing and in triplicate and shall –
(a) Contain the full names, occupation and address in Niue of the
person in whose favour it is granted;
(b) Specify each and every area or piece of land in relation to which it
is granted;
(c) Specify the term of the licence;
(d) Specify each and every species of minerals in respect of which the
licence is granted;
(e) Set forth the consideration, whether the payment of a lump sum or
otherwise, that the miner is to pay to the Crown for the grant of the
licence;
(f) Contain such other conditions, not inconsistent with this Act, as
are agreed upon between the miner concerned and Cabinet, being
conditions to which the licence is to be subject; and
(g) Be dated with the date of issue.
(2) Every licence shall be executed by the Premier in the presence of a
witness who shall, on the licence, duly attest the signature of the Premier.
(3) Every licence shall be signed by the miner concerned, or by the duly
authorised agent of such miner, in the presence of a Cabinet Minister or of a Mining
Inspector who shall, on the licence, duly attest the signature of the miner or agent.
(4) There shall be payable to the Crown on the issue of a licence the sum of
one hundred dollars.
(5) Every such sum shall be paid by the person in whose favour the licence
is granted.
(6) On the payment of any such fee, a receipt for the same shall be endorsed
upon each copy of the licence by the person duly authorised to receive the fee.

22 Validity of licence

No licence shall be valid or effectual for any purpose whatsoever until, in
relation to it there has been compliance with this Act.

23 Licence deemed to have been confirmed

Every licence issued or granted under this Act affecting or relating to Niuean
land, and every suspension, revocation or surrender of any such licence shall be
deemed to have been duly confirmed by the Court under the Land Act 1969.
1092 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

24 Registration of licence

(1) Every licence and every assignment, transmission, surrender or
revocation of any licence shall, for the purpose of Part 1 of the Land Act 1969, be
deemed to be an instrument within the meaning of section 2 of that Act and shall
be subject to Part 1 of that Act.
(2) Nothing in section 7 of the Land Act 1969 shall apply to a licence or to
the assignment, transmission, surrender or revocation of the licence.

25 Destruction of licence

(1) No person shall destroy or mutilate any licence or make any
unauthorised entry upon any licence.
(2) Any person who knowingly and wilfully acts contrary to subsection
(1) commits an offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit or, if the act was done with any fraudulent or other dishonest intent,
to a fine not exceeding 2.5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
6 months.

26 Licence to constitute contract

Every licence issued under this Act shall, subject to this Act, constitute a
contract between the Crown and the miner.

27 Surrender, cancellation and suspension of licence

Cabinet may suspend, cancel or cause the surrender of a licence if it is in
the national interest to do so.

28 Compensation

PART 5
COMPENSATION
Where land is acquired for the purposes of this Act, there shall be paid to the owner or occupier entitled to the land acquired compensation.

29 Claims for compensation against the Crown

Subject to this Act, every claim against the Crown for compensation in
respect of any matter for which compensation is expressly provided for by this
Act, whether for injurious affection of land, the value of improvements, or
otherwise, shall be made in the Court.

30 Payment of compensation

All compensation payable by the Crown under this Act shall be paid from
the Government Account out of money appropriated by the Assembly for that
purpose.

31 Compensation not payable in respect of minerals

Compensation shall in no case be payable in respect of the value of any
mineral on, in, under, or forming the surface of any land.

32 Compensation not payable unless expressly provided for

No person shall have any right or claim to compensation against the Crown
in respect of any matter arising under this Act except where provision for
compensation is expressly made by this Act.

Mining Act 1977 1093

33 Owner and occupier of land entitled to compensation

The owner or occupier of any land in respect of which a mining licence has
been granted shall be entitled to compensation (according to their respective
interests) for all loss and damage suffered or likely to be suffered by that owner or
occupier as a result of the grant of the mining licence or the exercise of the rights
conferred by that licence.

34 Amount of compensation

(1) The amount of compensation claimed under this Act against the holder
of a mining licence or against any person exercising any of the rights conferred by
this Act shall, in default of agreement, be determined by the Court.
(2) In fixing the amount of compensation to be paid to the owner or occupier
of land in respect of damage to the land, the Court shall take into consideration
the extent to which the whole of the land comprised in the holding of which the
land damaged forms part will be detrimentally affected by reason of any reduction
in the area usable for other than mining purposes.
PART 6
REGULATIONS

35 Regulations relating to mines

The Cabinet may make regulations for –
(a) Regulating the working of mines and machinery and providing for
the health and safety of persons working, and the safety of property
used, in connection with mining operations;
(b) Providing for the fencing off and filling up of shafts, pits, holes,
and excavations;
(c) Requiring owners of mines to provide such appliances, works, and
structures, for safety purposes, as may be specified in the
regulations, and requiring the owners to keep them in good repair
and condition;
(d) Regulating the use of cyanide and concentrating plants in or about
mines;
(e) Regulating the storage and use of explosives in or about mines;
(f) Regulating the use of electricity, and the installation and use of
electrical wiring and equipment, in or about mines;
(g) Providing for the safety of persons employed in drives and
excavations;
(h) Providing for the examination and inspection of mines and
machinery in or about mines;
(i) Requiring the use by persons employed in or about mines of
protective clothing, covering, or equipment of a prescribed kind to
be used in such work as may be specified;
(j) Requiring the provision of bathhouses, changehouses, toilets, and
other sanitary appliances at mines, and regulating their construction,
equipment, control and use;
(k) Requiring the provision in or about mines of supplies of drinking
water and facilities for the consumption of meals, and regulating
the construction, equipment and control, and use of such facilities;
(l) Providing for the supply and maintenance of fire extinguishing
appliances, ambulance appliances, and other appliances for use in
rescue work, and for the formation and training of rescue and first
aid teams;
1094 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(m) Requiring the installation of telephone communications between mines and the nearest places where medical assistance is obtainable;
(n) Prescribing forms of returns, and the nature of any information and particulars, to be supplied in respect of mines under this Act;
(o) Defining the duties of Mining Inspectors and conferring on those Inspectors all such powers as may be necessary for the efficient performance of their duties;
(p) Requiring copies of regulations made under this section to be displayed at mines.

36 General regulations

(1) Cabinet may make regulations for giving full or fuller effect to this Act.
(2) Without restricting subsection (1), Cabinet may under this section, make
regulations –
(a) Prescribing powers, functions, and duties of any officer or other
person appointed under this Act or employed or acting in the
administration of this Act;
(b) Prescribing forms to be used in conjunction with this Act;
(c) Prescribing the persons or class or classes of persons on whom
copies of applications for mining licences are to be served;
(d) Prescribing the fees payable in respect of applications for mining
licences and prospecting licences;
(e) Prescribing the rent payable in respect of mining operations;
(f) Prescribing the times at which rents shall be paid and the manner
in which they are to be paid;
(g) Prescribing the manner in which money payable under this Act is
to be collected, accounted for, and distributed;
(h) Providing for the compilation of mining statistics.
PART 7
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

37 Levies may be imposed

(1) (a) The Niue Assembly may, by resolution published in the Gazette,
impose on all or any minerals mined in, upon or under any land, a
levy or levies on the value of the minerals.
(b) The rate of any such levy shall not exceed 5 percent of the market
value of the minerals of the mine at which the same were mined on
the date of the mining.
(2) Every such levy shall be paid, by the miner who mined the minerals,
prior to the expiration of a period of 9 months from the date of mining of the
minerals.
(3) No minerals shall be exported from Niue, without the prior written
consent of Cabinet, until the levy payable in respect thereof has been paid under
subsections (1) and (2).
(4) Any such consent may be given either unconditionally or subject to
such conditions as Cabinet may impose.
(5) Any person who exports, or attempts to export, from Niue any minerals
contrary to subsection (3) commits an offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to
a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
6 months, or to both such a fine and such imprisonment, or, where the person is a
body corporate, to a fine not exceeding 40 penalty units.

Mining Act 1977 1095

(6) Nothing contained earlier in this section shall apply to any minerals obtained by a prospector consequent upon any prospecting of land made, under this Act or regulations made under this Act, by the prospector.

38 Moneys payable to the Treasurer

(1) Subject to subsection (4), all moneys payable by any miner under this
Act or any licence held by the miner shall constitute a debt due to the Crown, and
shall be paid to the Treasurer by the miner, or by any person receiving the same
under this Act from the miner or any agent of the miner.
(2) Should any such moneys not be duly and punctually paid, the same
may be recovered, on behalf of the Crown, by proceedings commenced and
prosecuted by the Treasurer or the Cabinet.
(3) All moneys received under subsection (1) by the Treasurer become part
of the general revenue of Niue.
(4) Nothing contained in this section shall apply to any fine payable or
paid by any person, as a penalty or punishment for any offence committed against
this Act by the person.

39 Money paid for Niuean land

Money paid for Niuean land acquired under this Act shall be paid to the
Registrar whereupon the Registrar shall dispose of the same to the owner or
occupier entitled.

40 Disputes

(1) (a) Any dispute arising under this Act shall be referred to a single
arbitrator chosen by the parties, or, if they are unable to agree, to an
arbitrator chosen by the Chief Justice.
(b) Each party shall have power to appoint an assessor to sit with the
arbitrator, but the arbitrator alone shall have the power to decide
and the award shall be his alone.
(2) Every arbitration shall take place within Niue as a single arbitrator
shall decide, and the procedure shall be governed by the Arbitration Act 1908.

41 Appeals

(1) Subject to subsection (5), any person claiming to be adversely affected
by any ruling, decision, instruction or direction made, given or issued under this
Act by Cabinet may appeal to the Court against the ruling, decision, instruction
or direction.
(2) No such appeal shall be made after the expiration of a period of 42
clear days from and after the date of the making, giving or issuing of the ruling,
decision, instruction or direction concerned.
(3) On the hearing of any such appeal the Court may –
(a) Dismiss the appeal;
(b) Allow the appeal;
(c) Allow the appeal in part and dismiss it in part;
(d) Modify the ruling, decision, instruction or direction, in such manner
and to such extent as it considers just; or
(e) Grant such further or other relief to the appellant as, in the
circumstances, it considers reasonable.
(4) –
1096 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(5) Nothing contained in this section shall empower any person to appeal against –
(a) Any refusal by Cabinet to grant a mining licence;
(b) Any refusal by Cabinet to consent to any assignment of a mining
licence;
(c) Any suspension by Cabinet of a mining licence.

42 Records to be kept

(1) Every miner shall keep in Niue complete, comprehensive, full, proper
and accurate records and books of account relating to all mining carried on by the
miner; and shall, on demand being made of the miner at any reasonable hour by
Cabinet or the Chief Mining Inspector, produce the same to the person making
the demand for inspection by that person; and that person shall be entitled, on
behalf of the Crown, to make and retain copies of the whole or any parts of the
records and books.
(2) Any miner who fails to comply with all or any of the provisions of
subsection (1) commits an offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units.

43 Disused mines

(1) Where any mine has, in the opinion of the Chief Mining Inspector,
become disused, the Chief Mining Inspector may give to any person who is lawfully
entitled to engage in mining at the mine such reasonable directions as the Chief
Mining Inspector considers necessary in order to render the mine safe and harmless
to any person, livestock or property.
(2) Any person to whom any directions are lawfully given under subsection
(1), and who fails within a reasonable time after the giving of them, fully to comply
with the same, commits an offence, and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(3) Notwithstanding subsection (1), the Chief Mining Inspector may take
such steps and measures to render any disused mine safe and harmless to any
person, livestock or property.
(4) The reasonable costs of taking any such steps and measures shall
constitute a debt due to the Crown by the person who would have been responsible
for rendering the disused mine safe and harmless, if the person had been lawfully
given directions in that behalf under subsection (1), and such costs may be
recovered by action brought, on behalf of the Crown, by the Chief Mining Inspector
or by the Treasurer.

44 Cabinet may delegate

Cabinet may, by notice in the Gazette, delegate to the Chief Mining Inspector
all or any of Cabinet’s functions, duties and powers under this Act and may in
like manner revoke, vary or amend any such delegation.

45 Personal liability of officers

No person shall be personally liable for any act done by him in good faith
in the exercise of any duties, powers, or authorities imposed or conferred on him
by this Act.

46 [Spent]

1097

MINORS’ CONTRACTS ACT 1969

1969/41 (NZ) – 1 January 1970

17-19 [Spent]

SCHEDULES

To restate and reform the law relating to minors’ contracts

1 Short title

This is the Minors’ Contracts Act 1969.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“property” means land, money, goods, things in action, goodwill, and every
valuable thing, whether real or personal, and whether situated in Niue
or elsewhere; and includes obligations, easements, and every
description of estate, interest, and profit, present or future, vested or
contingent, arising out of or incident to property.
(2) In sections 5, 6, 9, 10 and 12, “minor” does not include a minor who is
or has been married.

3 Act to bind the Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.

4 Married minors

Contractual Capacity of Minors

(1) Subject to section 16, a minor who is or has been married shall have the same contractual capacity as if he were of full age.
1098 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(2) Subject to section 16, any compromise or settlement of a claim agreed to, and any discharge or receipt given for any purpose, by any such minor shall have effect as if the minor were of full age.

5 Contracts of minors of or over the age of 18 years, certain contracts concerning life insurance, and contracts of service

(1) Subject to this section, every contract which is –
(a) Entered into by a minor who has attained the age of 18 years; or
(b) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(c) A contract of service entered into by a minor;
shall have effect as if the minor were of full age.
(2) If the Court is satisfied in respect of any contract to which subsection
(1) applies that, at the time the contract was entered into –
(a) The consideration for a minor ’s promise or act was so inadequate
as to be unconscionable; or
(b) Any provision of any such contract imposing an obligation on any
party thereto who was a minor was harsh or oppressive,
it may, in the course of any proceedings or on application made for the purpose,
cancel the contract, or decline to enforce the contract against the minor, or declare
that the contract is unenforceable against the minor, whether in whole or in part,
and in any case may make such order as to compensation or restitution of property
under section 7 as it thinks just.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2), the Court may receive evidence of
commercial practice in contracts of the same kind.
(4) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(5) Nothing in this section shall apply to –
(a) Any contract approved under section 9, or
(b) The compromise or settlement of any claim for money or damages
made by or on behalf of any minor (whether alone or in conjunction
with any other person).

6 Contracts of minors below the age of 18 years

(1) Subject to this section, every contract other than a contract to which
section 5(1)(b)or (c) applies entered into by a minor who has not attained the age
of 18 years shall be unenforceable against the minor but otherwise shall have effect
as if the minor were of full age.
(2) The Court may, in the course of any proceedings or on application made
for the purpose, inquire into the fairness and reasonableness of any contract to
which subsection (1) applies at the time the contract was entered into and –
(a) If it finds that any such contract was fair and reasonable at that
time it shall not be obliged to make any order but it may –
(i) enforce the contract against the minor;
(ii) declare that the contract is binding on the minor, whether in
whole or in part;
(iii) Make such order entitling the other parties to the contract, on
such conditions as the Court thinks just, to cancel the contract;
(iv) Make such order as to compensation or restitution of property
under section 7 as it thinks just, and

Minors’ Contracts Act 1969

1099
(b) If it finds that any such contract was not fair and reasonable at that time it shall not be obliged to make any order but it may –
(i) cancel the contract;
(ii) make such order entitling the minor, on such conditions as the
Court thinks just, to cancel the contract;
(iii) make such order as to compensation or restitution of property
under section 7 as it thinks just.
(3) In exercising its discretion under subsection (2) the Court shall have
regard to –
(a) The circumstances surrounding the making of the contract;
(b) The subject-matter and nature of the contract;
(c) In the case of a contract relating to property, the nature and the
value of the property;
(d) The age and the means (if any) of the minor;
(e) All other relevant circumstances.
(4) Nothing in this section shall apply to –
(a) Any contract approved by the Court under section 9; or
(b) The compromise or settlement of any claim for money or damages
made by or on behalf of any minor (whether alone or in conjunction
with any other person).
(5) Nothing in this section shall limit or affect section 20 of the Trustee Act
1956.

7 Compensation or restitution

(1) Where the Court exercises any of the powers conferred on it by section
5(2) or where it may exercise any of the powers conferred on it by section 6(2)
(whether or not it exercises any of those powers), the Court may grant to –
(a) Any party to the contract; or
(b) A guarantor or indemnifier under a contract of guarantee or
indemnity relating to a contract to which section 5(1) or section
6(1) applies; or
(c) Any person claiming through or under or on behalf of any such
party, guarantor, or indemnifier,
such relief by way of compensation or restitution of property as the Court thinks
just.
(2) The Court may by any order made under section (1) vest the whole or any part of any property that was the subject of, or the whole or any part of the consideration for, the contract in any party to the proceedings or may direct any such party to transfer or assign any such property to any other party to the proceedings.

8 Applications under section 5 or section 6

(1) An application under section 5(2) or section 6(2) may be made by –
(a) Any person to whom the Court may grant relief under section 7; or
(b) Any other person where it is material for that person to know
whether the Court will exercise the powers granted to it by the
subsection.
(2) Any order made under section 5(2) or section 6(2) or under section 7 or
any provision of any such order, may be made upon and subject to such terms
and conditions as the Court thinks fit.
1100 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

9 Minor may enter into contract with approval of the Court

(1) Every contract entered into by a minor shall have effect as if the minor
were of full age if, before the contract is entered into by the minor, it is approved
under this section by the Court.
(2) An application to the Court under this section may be made –
(a) By the minor or any other person who will be a party to the proposed
contract; or
(b) By a guardian of the minor.
(3) The Court may refer any such application to a guardian of the minor,
or, where the Court deems it necessary for the purposes of the application, to a
solicitor nominated by the Court, or to any other person, and may make such
order for the payment of the reasonable costs and expenses of any person to whom
the application is so referred.
(4) Any person to whom any such application is referred under subsection
(3) may file a report in the Court setting out the results of his consideration and
examination of the application and making in respect of it such recommendations
as he thinks proper, and may appear and be heard at the hearing of the application;
but no such person shall be under any obligation to consider or examine any such
application until his reasonable costs and expenses have been paid or secured to
his satisfaction.
(5) The Court shall not approve a contract under this section where the
contract relates to property held on trust and the Court is of the opinion that it is
a case in which it would be more appropriate for an application to be made under
section 64 or section 64A of the Trustee Act 1956.

Miscellaneous Provisions

10 Guarantees and indemnities

Every contract of guarantee or indemnity where any person (other than a
minor) undertakes to accept liability in the event of the failure of a minor to carry
out his obligations under a contract shall be enforceable against that person (in
this section referred to as “the surety”) to the extent that it would be if the minor
had been at all material times a person of full age, and that liability shall not be
affected by any other provision of this Act or by any order made under any other
provision of this Act; but the liability of the minor to the surety and the surety’s
right of subrogation against the minor may be affected by the other provisions of
this Act or by any order made under section 5(2) or section 6(2) or section 7.

11 Contracts to marry

No contract to marry any person entered into by a minor (other than a
minor who has been married) shall be binding on either party, and nothing in
section 5 or section 6 shall apply to any such contract.

12 Settlement of claims by minors

(1) Where any money or damages are claimed by or on behalf of a minor
(whether alone or in conjunction with any other person) then –
(a) If the claim is not the subject of proceedings before any Court in
Niue, any agreement for the compromise or settlement of the claim
entered into by the minor, or on his behalf by a person who in the
opinion of a Court of competent jurisdiction is a fit and proper
person to do so, shall be binding on the minor if it or a release of the
claim is in writing and is approved by a Court of competent
jurisdiction; and

Minors’ Contracts Act 1969

1101
(b) If the claim has not been compromised or settled in accordance with paragraph (a) and has become the subject of proceedings before any court in Niue, no settlement, compromise, or payment and no acceptance of money paid into Court, whenever entered into or made, shall so far as it relates to that minor ’s claim be valid without the approval of the Court.
(2) An application for the approval of the Court under subsection (1) may be made by or on behalf of the minor or any other party to the agreement or proceedings.
(3) The Court may refuse any application for its approval under subsection (1) or may grant its approval either unconditionally or upon or subject to such conditions and directions as it thinks fit, whether as to the terms of the agreement or of the compromise or settlement, or as to the amount, payment, securing, application, or protection of the money paid, or to be paid or otherwise.
(4) Without limiting subsection (3), where the Court directs that the whole
or any part of any money or damages awarded to a minor in any cause or matter
or of any money to which a minor is entitled under an agreement, compromise, or
settlement approved under subsection (1) shall be held on trust for the minor
under this subsection by a person then, except so far as the Court directs any
immediate payment therefrom or otherwise orders, and subject to any directions
or conditions given or imposed by the Court –
(a) The amount shall be invested and held by the trustee upon trust –
(i) to make such payment (if any) to the minor out of the income
and capital of the amount as the Court may specify; and
(ii) to apply the income and capital of the amount or so much
thereof as the trustee thinks fit for or towards the maintenance
or education (including past maintenance or education) or the
advancement or benefit of the minor;
(b) The minor shall have no power, either by himself or in conjunction
with any other person or persons, to terminate the trusts upon which
the amount is held or to modify or extinguish those trusts;
(c) The interest of the minor in the income and capital of the amount
shall not, while it remains in the hands of the trustee, be alienated,
or pass by bankruptcy, or be liable to be seized, sold, attached, or
taken in execution by process of law.
(5) (a) Upon any minor attaining the age of 20 years or marrying under
that age while any amount is held on trust for his benefit under
subsection (4), the balance of that amount and of the income
therefrom remaining in the hands of the trustee shall be paid to the
minor except in so far as the Court may have ordered before the
payment is made that the whole or any part of that amount shall
continue to be held on trust under that subsection.
(b) Where the trustee has made an application or received notice that
an application has been made to the Court for such an order he
shall not make any payment under this subsection until the
application has been disposed of.
(6) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(7) For the purposes of this section “court of competent jurisdiction” means
a court in which proceedings could be taken to enforce the claim or, in the case of
a claim that could not be the subject of proceedings in Niue, a court in which
proceedings could be taken to enforce a similar claim in Niue.
(8) Nothing in this section shall limit or affect the Deaths by Accidents
Compensation Act 1952.
1102 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

13 Variation of certain orders made under section 12

(1) The Court may vary any order made under section 12 insofar as the
order relates to the payment, investment, or application of money held on trust or
the income from such trust.
(2) Any order under this section may be made by the Court of its own
motion or on an application made by –
(a) The minor; or
(b) The trustee; or
(c) Any other person who adduces proof of circumstances which in
the opinion of the Court make it proper that he should make the
application.

14 Jurisdiction of Court

The Court may exercise any of the powers conferred by sections 5 to 7
where –
(a) The occasion for the exercise of the power arises in civil proceedings
(other than an application for the purposes of section 5(2) or section
6(2)) before the Court; or
(b) The value of the consideration for the promise or act of any minor
under the contract is no more than 2,000 dollars.

15 Act to be a code

(1) The provisions of this Act shall have effect in place of the rules of the
common law and of equity relating to the contractual capacity of minors and to
the effect, validity, avoidance, repudiation and ratification of contracts entered
into by minors and to any contract of guarantee or indemnity in respect of any
such contract.
(2) –
(3) Nothing in this Act shall limit or affect any provision of any other
enactment whereby a contract is made binding on a minor and nothing in section
5 or section 6 shall apply to any such contract.
(4) Nothing in this Act shall limit or affect the rule of law whereby a minor
is not liable in tort for procuring a contract by means of fraudulent representations
as to his own age or any other matter, but the Court shall take any such
representations into account in deciding whether to exercise any of its powers
under section 5(2) or section 6(2) or section 7.

16 Trusts not affected

Nothing in this Act shall entitle –
(a) A trustee to pay money or deliver property to a minor otherwise
than under the terms of the trust;
(b) A minor to enter into an agreement whereby a trust is extinguished
or the terms of a trust are varied but nothing in this section shall
prevent any contract approved under section 9 from having effect
according to its tenor.

17-19 [Spent]

–––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULES
[Not reproduced]
1103

MISUSE OF DRUGS ACT 1975

and

MISUSE OF DRUGS ACT 1998

[EDITORIAL NOTE: These are not reproduced. The Misuse of Drugs law is the subject of a current reform Bill. The two current Acts are therefore not reproduced. They can be accessed in New Zealand Acts 1975/116 as extended to Niue by section 689A of the Niue Act 1966 and in Niue Legislation Supplement 1997-1998 p87 respectively.]

1104 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

1105

MOSQUITO CONTROL ACT 1980

1980/63 – 10 November 1980

1

Short title

7

Continuing non-compliance

2

Interpretation

8

Absent persons with mosquito control

3

Duty to keep land and premises clear of

responsibilities

mosquitoes

9

Offences

4

Littering and dumping prohibited

10

[Spent]

5

Duties and powers of Health Inspectors

6

Non-compliance with a Mosquito Control

Order

To provide for the enforcement of mosquito control measures for the protection of the public health from diseases transmitted by mosquitoes

1 Short title

This is the Mosquito Control Act 1980.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“building” means any construction whatsoever and includes any shop,
school, hospital, hall, church, house, outside kitchen or out-house, but
does not include a shed constructed in the bush for storage purposes;
“dwelling” means any building used for the purpose of human habitation;
“Health Inspector” means any Inspector of Health appointed under section
7 of the Public Health Act 1965;
“mosquito control order” means an order made by a Health Inspector under
section 5.

3 Duty to keep land and premises clear of mosquitoes

Every person who uses the land belonging to any dwelling or building or
who is responsible for the care and management of such dwelling or building, is
under a duty to ensure that –
(a) All land around any building or dwelling shall be kept clear of
mosquito breeding and nesting places as hereinafter provided;
(b) No water shall be stored (except in appropriate quantities for
domestic use) in any receptacle capable of holding water, unless
adequately protected against mosquitoes;
(c) Any such land shall be kept clear of bush, scrub and any mass of
rotting vegetation likely to harbour mosquitoes within a radius of
60 metres from any dwelling or building;
(d) Any such land shall be kept clear of any bottle (whole or broken),
tin, coconut shell, or any other article whatsoever likely to retain
water and so become a breeding place for mosquitoes.
1106 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

4 Littering and dumping prohibited

Every person who litters or dumps on any land whatsoever (not being
land designated for that purpose by Cabinet), any bottle (whole or broken), tin,
coconut shell, shell or any other article whatsoever likely to retain water commits
an offence.

5 Duties and powers of Health Inspectors

(1) Any duly appointed Health Inspector may enter on and inspect any
land or premises at any reasonable time for the purpose of ensuring compliance
with section 3.
(2) Whenever a Health Inspector ascertains –
(a) The presence of mosquitoes or mosquito larvae;
(b) The location of breeding or resting places of mosquitoes;
he shall make an order prescribing necessary and practical measures for the
eradication of those mosquitoes and mosquito larvae.
(3) Whenever a Health Inspector makes an order under subsection (2) and
that order is not complied with within 7 days he shall begin prosecution under
this Act.

6 Non-compliance with a Mosquito Control Order

Every person who fails to perform his or her mosquito control duty as
defined under section 3 and who fails to abide by an order of a Health Inspector
within 7 days of such order commits an offence.

7 Continuing non-compliance

Every person who has been convicted of an offence against section 6 and
who fails to comply with the Health Inspector ’s order within 7 days after such
conviction commits a further offence.

8 Absent persons with mosquito control responsibilities

In any case where –
(a) Any person having responsibilities under section 3 has departed
from Niue without appointing an agent to act in his stead in
performing those responsibilities; and
(b) A Health Inspector has made an order in respect of land for which
that person is responsible;
the court, on application by the Director of Health may make an order for the
Director of Works to enter on the land and at the expense of the responsible person
carry out the work as specified in the Court order, and all such expenses shall be
recoverable from that person as a debt to the Crown.

9 Offences

Every person who commits an offence against this Act shall on conviction
be liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units and save in exceptional
circumstances not less than 0.5 penalty units.

10 [Spent]

1107

MUTUAL ASSISTANCE IN CRIMINAL MATTERS ACT 1998

1998/244 – 16 December 1998

20 Conditions of imprisonment

21 Release of certain persons upon request by

foreign country

22 Arrest of person who has escaped from

custody

23 Aiding person to escape

Requests by Foreign Countries

24 Requests for giving evidence at hearings in

foreign countries

25 Requests for assistance in relation to

investigations in foreign countries

26 Effect of removal to foreign country on

prisoner ’s terms of imprisonment

ASSISTANCE IN IDENTIFYING AND LOCATING PERSONS

10A Requests by Niue

10B Requests by foreign countries

PART 2

ASSISTANCE IN RELATION TO TAKING OF EVIDENCE

AND PRODUCTION OF DOCUMENTS OR OTHER

ARTICLES

11 Requests by Niue

12 Requests by foreign countries

PART 3

ASSISTANCE IN RELATION TO SEARCH AND SEIZURE

13 Requests by Niue for search and seizure

14 Requests by foreign countries for search

and seizure

PART 4

ARRANGEMENTS FOR PERSONS TO GIVE EVIDENCE OR

ASSIST INVESTIGATIONS

Requests by Niue

15 Requests for removal of certain persons to

Niue

16 Custody of certain persons

17 Immunities

18 Status of person prosecuted for offence

committed after departure from foreign

country

19 Limitation on use of evidence given by

certain persons

PART 5

CUSTODY OF PERSONS IN TRANSIT

27 Transit

28 Arrest of person in transit

29 Aiding person to escape

PART 6

PROCEEDS OF CRIME

Requests by Niue

30 Requests for enforcement of orders

31 Requests for issue of orders in foreign

countries

Requests by Foreign Countries

32 Requests for enforcement of orders

33 Requests for search and seizure warrants

in respect of tainted property

34 Requests for restraining orders

35 Requests for information gathering orders

35A Cabinet may approve proposals for sharing certain property

PART 7

REQUESTS BY OR ON BEHALF OF A DEFENDANT

36 Requests by Attorney-General on behalf of

a defendant

37 Certificate by Attorney-General if foreign

country refuses request made under section

36

1108 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

PART 8

ADMISSIBILITY OF FOREIGN EVIDENCE

38

39

Preliminary

Interpretation

Proceedings to which this Part applies

40

41

42

Obtaining Foreign Material Requests for foreign material Requirements for testimony Form of testimony

43

Using Foreign Material

Foreign material may be adduced as

evidence

44

Direction to prevent foreign material being

adduced

For the provision and obtaining of international assistance in criminal matters

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998.

2 [Spent]

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Attorney-General” has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act
1998;
“Commissioner” means a Commissioner of the Court;
“confiscation order” means a confiscation order within the meaning of the
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
“criminal matter” means an offence against a provision of –
(a) Any law of Niue that is a serious offence; or
(b) A law of a foreign country, in relation to acts or omissions, which
had they occurred in Niue, would have constituted a serious offence;
“criminal proceeding”, in relation to an offence, means a trial of a person
for the offence or a proceeding in respect of the offence to determine
whether a person should be tried for the offence (whether or not a
particular person is specified at the commencement of that proceeding
as the person in relation to whom the determination is to be made);
“facsimile copy” means a copy obtained or sent by facsimile transmission;
“foreign confiscation order” means an order made under the law of a foreign
country for a person to pay to the foreign country an amount
representing the value (or part thereof) of the person’s benefits from an
offence against the law of that country;
“foreign forfeiture order” means an order, made under the law of a foreign
country, for the forfeiture of property in respect of an offence against
the law of that country;

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1109
“foreign law immunity certificate” means a certificate given, or a declaration made, by a foreign country or under a law of a foreign country , certifying or declaring that, under the law of the foreign country, persons generally or a specified person could or could not, either generally or in specified proceedings and either generally or in specified circumstances, be required –
(a) To answer a specified question; or
(b) To produce a specified document;
“foreign prisoner” means a person who is being held in custody pending
trial for, or sentence for, or is under a sentence of imprisonment for an
offence against a law of a foreign country, but does not include a person
who is at large after having escaped from lawful custody;
“foreign restraining order” means an order, made under the law of a foreign
country, restraining a particular person, or all persons, from dealing
with property, being an order made in respect of an offence against the
law of that country;
“forfeiture order”means a forfeiture order within the meaning of the
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
“money laundering offence” means an offence within the terms of sections
64 and 65 of the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
“offence” includes an offence against a law relating to taxation, customs
duties or other revenue matters or relating to foreign exchange control;
“prisoner” means a person who is being held in custody pending trail for,
or sentence for, or is under a sentence of imprisonment for, an offence
against a law of Niue, but does not include a person who is at large
after having escaped from lawful custody;
“prison” includes a jail, lock-up or other place of detention;
“proceeds” has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
“proceeding” in relation to a criminal matter, includes a proceeding before
a judicial officer or a jury of the purpose of –
(a) Gathering evidential material that may lead to the laying of a
criminal charge; or
(b) Assessing evidential material in support of the laying of a criminal
charge;
“property” has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
“property-tracking document” has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of
Crime Act 1998;
“restraining order” means a restraining order within the meaning of the
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998;
“serious offence” means an offence the maximum penalty for which is death,
or imprisonment for not less than 12 months;
“tainted property” has the same meaning as in the Proceeds of Crime Act
1998;
“trial”, in relation to an offence in a foreign country, includes any proceeding
to determine whether a person should be convicted of the offence;
“video link” means a video and sound system that enables persons
assembled in a place in a country to see, hear and talk to persons
assembled in a place in another country.
1110 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

4 Object of Act

The objects of this Act are –
(a) To regulate the provision by Niue of international assistance in
criminal matters when a request is made by a foreign country for
any of the following –
(i) the taking of the evidence, or the production of any document
or other article, for the purposes of a proceeding in the foreign
country;
(ii) the issue of a search warrant and the seizure of any thing
relevant to a proceeding or investigation in the foreign country;
(iii) the forfeiture and confiscation of property in respect of a serious
offence against the law of the foreign country;
(iv) the restraining of dealings in property that may be forfeited or
confiscated because of the commission of a serious offence
against the law of the foreign country;
(v) the giving of assistance in locating, or in identifying and
locating, a person believed to be in Niue and believed to be a
person who is or might be concerned in, or who could give or
provide evidence or assistance relevant to, a criminal matter in
the foreign country; and
(b) To facilitate the provision and obtaining by Niue of international
assistance in criminal matters when a request is made by a foreign
country for the making of arrangements for a person who is in Niue
to travel to the foreign country to give evidence in a proceeding or
to give assistance in relation to an investigation; and
(c) To facilitate the obtaining by Niue of international assistance in
criminal matters.

5 Act not to limit other provision of assistance

This Act does not prevent the provision or obtaining of international
assistance in criminal matters other than assistance of a kind that may be provided
or obtained under this Act.

6 Application

This Act applies to all foreign countries.

7 Refusal of assistance

A request by a foreign country for assistance under this Act may be refused
if, in the opinion of the Attorney-General, the provision of the assistance would –
(a) Prejudice the national, essential or public interests of Niue; or
(b) Result in manifest unfairness or a denial of human rights; or
(c) It is otherwise appropriate, in all the circumstances of the case, that
the assistance requested should not be granted.

8 Assistance may be provided subject to conditions

Assistance under this Act may be provided to a foreign country subject to
such conditions as the Attorney-General determines.

9 Requests by Niue

(1) A request for international assistance in a criminal matter that Niue is
authorised to make under this Act may be made only by the Attorney-General.
(2) Subsection (1) does not prevent the Attorney-General on behalf of Niue
from requesting international assistance in a criminal matter of a kind that may
not be requested under this Act.

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1111

10 Request by foreign country

(1) A request by a foreign country for international assistance in a criminal
matter may be made to the Attorney-General or a person authorised by the
Attorney-General to receive requests by foreign countries under this Act.
(2) A request must be in writing and must include or be accompanied by
the following information –
(a) The name of the authority concerned with the criminal matter to
which the request relates;
(b) A description of the nature of the criminal matter and a statement
setting out a summary of the relevant facts and laws;
(c) A description of the purpose of the request and of the nature of the
assistance being sought;
(d) Any information that may assist in giving effect to the request,
but failure to comply with this subsection is not a ground for refusing the request.
(3) Where a request by a foreign country is made to a person authorised
under subsection (1), the request shall be taken, for the purposes of this Act, to
have been made to the Attorney-General.
(4) If a foreign country makes a request to a court in Niue for international
assistance in a criminal matter –
(a) The court must refer the request to the Attorney-General; and
(b) The request is then to be taken, for the purposes of the Act, to have
been made to the Attorney-General.
PART 1A
ASSISTANCE IN IDENTIFYING AND LOCATING PERSONS

10A Requests by Niue

(1) This subsection applies if the Attorney-General is satisfied that there
are reasonable grounds for believing that there is, in a foreign country, a person
who –
(a) Is or might be concerned in, or affected by, any criminal matter in
Niue; or
(b) Could give or provide evidence or assistance relevant to any
criminal matter in Niue.
(2) If subsection (1) applies, the Attorney-General may request the foreign
country –
(a) To assist in locating the person; or
(b) If the person’s identity is unknown, to assist in identifying and
locating the person.

10B Requests by foreign countries

(1) A foreign country may request the Attorney-General to assist in locating,
or identifying and locating, a person who is believed to be in Niue.
(2) The Attorney-General may authorise assistance in accordance with this
section if satisfied that –
(a) The request relates to a criminal matter in the foreign country; and
(b) There are reasonable grounds for believing that the person to whom
the request relates is in Niue and –
(i) is or might be concerned in the criminal matter; or
(ii) could give or provide evidence or assistance relevant to the
criminal matter.
1112 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(3) If the Attorney-General authorises assistance in accordance with this section, the Attorney-General must forward the request to the appropriate authority in Niue, and that authority must –
(a) Use its best endeavours to locate or, as the case may be, identify and locate the person to whom the request relates; and
(b) Advise the Attorney-General of the outcome of those endeavours.
(4) On receiving advice from the appropriate authority under subsection
(3)(b), the Attorney-General must inform the requesting country of the result of
the inquiries made pursuant to the request concerned.
PART 2
ASSISTANCE IN RELATION TO TAKING OF EVIDENCE AND PRODUCTION OF
DOCUMENTS OR OTHER ARTICLES

11 Requests by Niue

(1) The Attorney-General may request the appropriate authority of a foreign
country to arrange for –
(a) Evidence to be taken in the foreign country under the law of that
country; or
(b) A document or other article in the foreign country to be produced
in accordance with the law of that country;
for the purposes of a proceeding or investigation in relation to a criminal matter
in Niue.
(2) When making a request under subsection (1) the Attorney-General may
also request that an opportunity be given for the person giving the evidence, or
producing the document or other article, to be examined or cross-examined,
through a video link, from Niue by –
(a) Any party to the proceeding or that person’s legal representative;
or
(b) Any person being investigated or that person’s legal representative.

12 Requests by foreign countries

(1) Where a request is made by a foreign country (requesting country) that –
(a) Evidence be taken in Niue ; or
(b) Documents or other articles in Niue be produced;
for the purposes of a proceeding or investigation in the requesting country or
another foreign country, the Attorney-General may authorise the taking of the
evidence or the production of the documents or other articles, and the transmission
of the evidence, documents or other articles to the requesting country.
(2) Where the Attorney-General authorises the taking of evidence or the
production of documents or other articles under subsection (1) –
(a) In the case of the taking of evidence, a Commissioner may take the
evidence on oath of each witness appearing before the
Commissioner to give evidence in relation to the matter, and a
Commissioner who takes any such evidence shall –
(i) cause the evidence to be put in writing and certify that the
evidence was taken by the Commissioner; and
(ii) cause the writing so certified to be sent to the Attorney-General;
or
(b) In the case of the production of documents or other articles, a
Commissioner may, subject to subsection (6), require the production
of the documents or other articles and, where the documents or
other articles are produced, the Commissioner shall send the

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1113
documents, or copies of the documents certified by the Commissioner to be true copies, or the other articles, to the Attorney- General.
(3) The evidence of such a witness may be taken in the presence or absence of the person to whom the proceeding in the requesting country relates or of his or her legal representative (if any).
(4) The Commissioner conducting a proceeding under subsection (2) may permit –
(a) The person to whom the proceeding in the requesting country
relates;
(b) Any other person giving evidence or producing documents or other
articles at the proceeding before the Commissioner; and
(c) The relevant authority of the requesting country;
to have legal representation at the proceeding before the Commissioner.
(5) If the requesting country has so requested, the Commissioner
conducting a proceeding under subsection (2) may permit –
(a) Any person to whom the proceeding in the requesting country
relates or that person’s legal representative; or
(b) The legal representative of the relevant authority of the requesting
country;
to examine or cross-examine, through a video link, from the requesting country
any person giving evidence or producing a document or other article, at the
proceeding.
(6) The certificate by the Commissioner under subsection (2) shall state
whether, when the evidence was taken or the documents or other articles were
produced, any of the following persons were present –
(a) The person to whom the proceeding in the requesting country
relates or his or her legal representative (if any);
(b) Any other person giving evidence or producing documents or other
articles or his or her legal representative (if any).
(7) Subject to subsections (8) and (9), laws with respect to the compelling
of persons to attend before a Commissioner, and to give evidence, answer questions
and produce documents or other articles, upon the hearing of a charge against a
person for an offence against the law of Niue apply, so far as they are capable of
application, with respect to the compelling of persons to attend before a
Commissioner, and to give evidence, answer questions and produce documents
or other articles, for the purposes of this section.
(8) For the purposes of this section, the person to whom the proceeding in
the requesting country relates is competent but not compellable to give evidence.
(9) For the purposes of this section, a person who is required to give
evidence, or produce documents or other articles, for the purposes of a proceeding
in relation to a criminal matter in the requesting or another foreign country, is not
compellable to answer a question, or produce a document or article, that the person
is not compellable to answer or produce, as the case may be, in the proceeding in
that country.
(10) A duly authenticated foreign law immunity certificate is admissible in
proceedings under this section as prima facie evidence of the matters stated in the
certificate.
1114 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
PART 3
ASSISTANCE IN RELATION TO SEARCH AND SEIZURE

13 Requests by Niue for search and seizure

(1) This section applies to a proceeding or investigation relating to a
criminal matter involving a serious offence against the law of Niue if there are
reasonable grounds to believe that a thing relevant to the proceeding or
investigation may be located in a foreign country.
(2) If this section applies to a proceeding or investigation, the Attorney-
General may request the appropriate authority of the foreign country to obtain a
warrant or other instrument that, in accordance with the law of the foreign country,
authorises –
(a) A search for a thing relevant to the proceeding or investigation;
and,
(b) If such a thing, or any other thing that is or may be relevant to the
proceeding or investigation is found as a result of the search, the
seizure of that thing.
(3) If the appropriate authority of the foreign country has obtained any
thing relevant to the proceeding or investigation by means of a process authorised
by the law of that country other than the issue (as requested by Niue) of a warrant
or other instrument authorising the seizure of the thing, the thing –
(a) Is not inadmissible in evidence in the proceeding; or
(b) Is not precluded from being used for the purposes of the
investigation;
on the ground alone that it was obtained otherwise than under the request.

14 Requests by foreign countries for search and seizure

(1) Where –
(a) A proceeding or investigation relating to a criminal matter involving
a serious offence has commenced in a foreign country;
(b) There are reasonable grounds to believe that a thing relevant to
the investigation or proceeding is located in Niue; and
(c) The foreign country requests the Attorney-General to arrange for
the issue of a search warrant under this section in relation to that
thing;
the Attorney-General may authorise a constable to apply to a Commissioner for
the search warrant requested by the foreign country.
(2) A constable authorised under subsection (1) may apply to a
Commissioner for the issue of a warrant to search land or premises for the thing
to which the request relates.
(3) Where an application is made under subsection (2) for a warrant to
search land or premises in Niue for a thing relevant to an investigation or
proceeding in a foreign country the Commissioner may issue a warrant of that
kind.
(4) If, in the course of searching, under a warrant issued under this section, for a thing of a kind specified in the warrant, the constable finds another thing that the constable believes on reasonable grounds­
(a) To be relevant to the proceeding or investigation in the foreign
country or to afford evidence as to the commission of a Niue criminal
offence; and
(b) Is likely to be concealed, lost or destroyed if it is not seized;
the warrant shall be deemed to authorise the constable to seize the other thing.

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1115
(5) Where a constable finds, as a result of a search under a warrant issued under this section, a thing which the constable seizes wholly or partly because he or she believes the thing on reasonable grounds to be relevant to the proceeding or investigation in the foreign country, the constable shall deliver the thing into the custody and control of the Chief of Police.
(6) Where a thing is delivered into the custody and control of the Chief of
Police under subsection (5), the Chief of Police shall inform the Attorney-General
that the thing has been so delivered and arrange for the thing to be kept pending
a direction in writing from the Attorney-General as to the manner in which the
thing is to be dealt with (which may include a direction that the thing be sent to an
authority of a foreign country).
PART 4
ARRANGEMENTS FOR PERSONS TO GIVE EVIDENCE OR ASSIST INVESTIGATIONS

Requests by Niue

15 Requests for removal of certain persons to Niue

(1) Where –
(a) A proceeding relating to a criminal matter has commenced in Niue;
and
(b) The Attorney-General is of the opinion that a person who is in a
foreign country –
(i) is a foreign prisoner;
(ii) is capable of giving evidence relevant to the proceeding; and
(iii) has given his or her consent to being removed to Niue for the
purpose of giving evidence in the proceeding;
the Attorney-General may request the foreign country to authorise the attendance of the person at a hearing in connection with the proceeding.
(2) Where –
(a) An investigation relating to a criminal matter has commenced in
Niue; and
(b) The Attorney-General is of the opinion that a person who is in a
foreign country –
(i) is a foreign prisoner;
(ii) is capable of giving assistance in relation to the investigation;
and
(iii) has given his or her consent to being removed to Niue for the
purposes of giving assistance in relation to the investigation,
the Attorney-General may request the foreign country to authorise the removal of
the person to Niue for the purpose of giving assistance in relation to the
investigation.
(3) Where the Attorney-General makes a request under subsection (1) or
(2), the Attorney-General may make arrangements with an appropriate authority
of the foreign country for the purposes of –
(a) The removal of the person to Niue;
(b) The custody of the person while in Niue;
(c) The return of the person to the foreign country; and
(d) Other relevant matters.
1116 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

16 Custody of certain persons

Where –
(a) A person is to be brought to Niue from a foreign country pursuant
to a request under section 15; and
(b) The foreign country requests that the person be kept in custody
while he or she is in Niue,
the person shall, while the person is in Niue or travelling to or from Niue pursuant
to the request, be kept in such custody as the Attorney-General directs in writing.

17 Immunities

(1) Where a person is in Niue –
(a) Pursuant to a request under section 15; or
(b) To give evidence in a proceeding, or to give assistance in relation to
an investigation, pursuant to a request made by or on behalf of the
Attorney-General (not being a request under section 15) for
international assistance in a criminal matter;
the person, subject to subsection (2), shall not –
(c) Be detained, prosecuted or punished in Niue for any offence that is
alleged to have been committed, or that was committed, before the
person’s departure from the foreign country pursuant to the request;
(d) Be subjected to any civil suit in respect of any act or omission of the
person that is alleged to have occurred or that occurred, before the
person’s departure from the foreign country under the request,
being a civil suit to which the person could not be subjected if the
person were not in Niue;
(e) Be required to give evidence in any proceeding in Niue other than
the proceeding to which the request relates (if any);
(f) Be required, in the proceeding to which the request relates (if any),
to answer any question that the person would not be required to
answer in a proceeding in the foreign country relating to a criminal
matter; or
(g) Be required, in the proceeding to which the request relates (if any),
to produce any document or article that the person would not be
required to produce in a proceeding in the foreign country relating
to a criminal matter.
(2) A duly authorised foreign law immunity certificate is admissible in
proceedings as prima facie evidence of the matters stated in the certificate.
(3) Subsection (1) ceases to apply to a person if –
(a) The person has left Niue; or
(b) The person has had the opportunity of leaving Niue and has
remained in Niue otherwise than for –
(i) the purpose to which the request relates;
(ii) the purpose of giving evidence in a proceeding in Niue certified
by the Attorney-General, in writing, to be a proceeding in which
it is desirable that the person give evidence; or
(iii) the purpose of giving assistance in relation to an investigation
in Niue certified by the Attorney-General, in writing, to be an
investigation in relation to which it is desirable that the person
give assistance.
(4) A certificate given by the Attorney-General for the purposes of
subsection (2)(b)(ii) or (iii) has effect from the day specified in the certificate (which
may be a day before the day on which the certificate is given).

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1117

18 Status of person prosecuted for offence committed after departure from foreign country

(1) Where a person has come to Niue pursuant to a request under section
15, the person shall be taken, for the purposes of this Act, to be in Niue pursuant
to the request during any period during which the person remains in Niue for the
purpose of being tried for a criminal offence against the law of Niue that the person
is alleged to have committed after the person’s departure from the foreign country.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the person shall be
kept in such custody as the Attorney-General directs under section 16.

19 Limitation on use of evidence given by certain persons

(1) Where –
(a) A person is in Niue to give evidence in a proceeding –
(i) because of a request under section 15(1); or
(ii) because of a request (other than a request under section 15(1))
made by the Attorney-General for international assistance in a
criminal matter; and
(b) The person has given evidence in the proceeding to which the
request related or in a proceeding certified by the Attorney-General
under section 17(3)(b)(ii) in relation to the person;
that evidence shall not be admitted or otherwise used in any prosecution of the
person for an offence against Niue law, other than the offence of perjury in relation
to the giving of that evidence.
(2) If –
(a) A person is in Niue to give assistance in relation to an investigation

(i) because of a request under section 15(2); or
(ii) because of a request (other than a request under section 15(2))
made by the Attorney-General for international assistance in a
criminal matter; and
(b) The person has given assistance in relation to the investigation to
which the request related or in relation to an investigation certified
by the Attorney-General under section 17(3)(b)(ii) in relation to the
person;
anything said or done by the person when giving the assistance is not to be
admitted or otherwise used in any prosecution of the person for an offence against
Niue law.

20 Conditions of imprisonment

The laws of Niue with respect to –
(a) The conditions of imprisonment of persons imprisoned for offences
against the law of Niue; and
(b) The treatment of any such persons during imprisonment; and
(c) The transfer of any such persons from prison to prison;
apply, so far as they are capable of application, in relation to a person who is in
Niue in pursuance of a request under section 15 and who has been committed to
prison in Niue under a direction of the Attorney-General under this Act.
1118 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

21 Release of certain persons upon request by foreign country

Where –
(a) A person is being held in custody under a direction of the Attorney-
General under section 16; and
(b) The foreign country from which the person has been brought
requests the release of the person from custody;
the Attorney-General shall direct that the person be released from custody.

22 Arrest of person who has escaped from custody

(1) Any constable, without warrant, may arrest a person, if the constable
has reasonable grounds to believe that the person –
(a) Has been brought to Niue pursuant to a request under section 15;
and
(b) Has escaped from lawful custody while in Niue pursuant to the
request.
(2) The constable must, as soon as practicable, take the person before a
Commissioner.
(3) If the Commissioner is satisfied that the person has escaped from lawful
custody, the Commissioner may issue a warrant authorising any constable to return
the person to lawful custody.

23 Aiding person to escape

The laws of Niue in relation to –
(a) Aiding a prisoner to escape from custody;
(b) Rescuing a prisoner from custody;
(c) Permitting escape; and
(d) Harbouring an escapee,
apply in respect of a person who is in custody in Niue under a request to a foreign
country by Niue under this Act.

Requests by Foreign Countries

24 Requests for giving of evidence at hearings in foreign countries

(1) Where –
(a) A proceeding relating to a criminal matter has commenced in a
foreign country;
(b) The foreign country requests the attendance at a hearing in
connection with the proceeding of a prisoner who is in Niue
(whether or not in custody);
(c) There are reasonable grounds to believe that the prisoner is capable
of giving evidence relevant to the proceeding; and
(d) The Attorney-General is satisfied that –
(i) the prisoner has consented to giving evidence in the foreign
country; and
(ii) the foreign country has given adequate (whether or not
unqualified) undertakings in respect of the matters referred to
in subsection (3);
the Attorney-General may –
(e) In a case where the prisoner is being held in custody, direct that the
prisoner be released from prison for the purpose of travelling to
the foreign country to give evidence at the proceeding and, subject
to the making or giving of any necessary directions or approvals in
relation to the release of the prisoner, make arrangements for the

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1119
travel of the prisoner to the foreign country in the custody of a constable or prison officer appointed by the Attorney-General for the purpose; or
(f) In a case where the prisoner, having been released from custody on a parole or other order or licence to be at large, is not being held in custody, approve the travel of the prisoner to the foreign country to give evidence at the proceeding and obtain such approvals, authorities, permissions or variations to the parole or other order or licence to be at large as may be required and, subject to the obtaining of any necessary approvals, authorities, permissions or variations of the parole or other order or licence to be at large, make arrangements for the travel of the prisoner to the foreign country.
(2) Where –
(a) A proceeding relating to a criminal matter has commenced in a
foreign country;
(b) The foreign country requests the attendance at a hearing in
connection with the proceeding of a person (not being a prisoner)
who is in Niue;
(c) There are reasonable grounds to believe that the person is capable
of giving evidence relevant to the proceeding; and
(d) The Attorney-General is satisfied that the person has consented to
giving evidence in the foreign country, and the foreign country has
given adequate (whether or not unqualified) undertakings in
respect of the matters referred to in subsection (3);
the Attorney-General may make arrangements for the travel of the person to the
foreign country.
(3) The matters in relation to which undertakings are to be given by a
foreign country for the purpose of a request that a person give evidence in the
foreign country are –
(a) That the person shall not –
(i) be detained, prosecuted or punished for any offence against
the law of the foreign country that is alleged to have been
committed, or that was committed, before the person’s
departure from Niue;
(ii) be subjected to any civil suit in respect of any act or omission
of the person that is alleged to have occurred, or that occurred,
before the person’s departure from Niue, being a civil suit to
which the person could not be subjected if the person were not
in the foreign country; or
(iii) be required to give evidence in any proceeding in the foreign
country other than the proceeding to which the request relates;
unless the person has left the foreign country or the person has had
the opportunity of leaving the foreign country and has remained in
that country otherwise than for the purpose of giving evidence in
the proceeding to which the request relates;
(b) That any evidence given by the person in the proceeding to which
the request relates will be inadmissible or otherwise disqualified
from use in the prosecution of the person for an offence against a
law of the foreign country other than the offence of perjury in
relation to the giving of that evidence;
(c) That the person will be returned to Niue under arrangements agreed
by the Attorney-General;
1120

25

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

(d) In a case where the person is being held in custody in Niue and the Attorney-General requests the foreign country to make arrangements for the keeping of the person in custody while the person is in the foreign country –
(i) the making of appropriate arrangements for that purpose;
(ii) that the person will not be released from custody in the foreign
country unless the Attorney General notifies an appropriate
authority of the foreign country that the person is entitled to
be released from custody under Niue law; and
(iii) if the person is released in the foreign country as mentioned
in subparagraph (ii), that the person’s accommodation and
expenses pending the completion of the proceeding to which
the request relates will be paid for by the foreign country; and
(iv) such other matters (if any) as the Attorney-General thinks
appropriate.

Requests for assistance in relation to investigations in foreign countries

(1) Where –
(a) An investigation relating to a criminal matter has commenced in a
foreign country;
(b) The foreign country requests the removal of a prisoner who is in
Niue (whether or not in custody) to the foreign country for the
purpose of giving assistance in relation to the investigation;
(c) There are reasonable grounds to believe that the prisoner is capable
of giving assistance in relation to the investigation; and
(d) The Attorney-General is satisfied that –
(i) the prisoner has consented to being removed to the foreign
country for the purpose of giving assistance in relation to the
investigation; and
(ii) the foreign country has given adequate (whether or not
unqualified) undertakings in respect of the matters referred to
in subsection (3);
the Attorney-General may,
(e) In a case where the prisoner is being held in custody, direct that the
prisoner be released from prison for the purpose of traveling to the
foreign country to give assistance in relation to the investigation
and, subject to the making or giving of any necessary directions or
approvals in relation to the release of the prisoner, make
arrangements for the travel of the prisoner to the foreign country
in the custody of a constable or prison officer appointed by the
Attorney-General for the purpose; or
(f) In a case where the prisoner, having been released from custody on
a parole or other order or licence to be at large, is not being held in
custody, approve the travel of the prisoner to the foreign country
for the purpose of giving assistance in relation to the investigation
and obtain such approvals, authorities, permissions or variations
to the parole or other order or licence to be at large as may be
required and, make arrangements for the travel of the prisoner to
the foreign country.

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1121
(2) Where –
(a) An investigation relating to a criminal matter has commenced in a
foreign country;
(b) The foreign country requests that a person (not being a prisoner)
who is in Niue travel to the foreign country to give assistance in
relation to the investigation;
(c) There are reasonable grounds to believe that the person is capable
of giving assistance in relation to the investigation; and
(d) the Attorney-General is satisfied that –
(i) the person has consented to travel to the foreign country for
the purpose of giving assistance in relation to the investigation;
and
(ii) the foreign country has given adequate (whether or not
unqualified) undertakings in respect of the matters referred to
in subsection (3);
the Attorney -General may make arrangements for the travel of the person to the
foreign country.
(3) The matters in relation to which undertakings are to be given by a
foreign country for the purpose of a request that a person be removed to, or travel
to, the foreign country for the purpose of giving assistance in relation to an
investigation are –
(a) That the person shall not –
(i) be detained, prosecuted or punished for any offence against
the law of the foreign country that is alleged to have been
committed, or that was committed, before the person’s
departure from Niue;
(ii) be subjected to any civil suit in respect of any act or omission
of the person that is alleged to have occurred, or that occurred,
before the person’s departure from Niue, being a civil suit to
which the person could not be subjected if the person were not
in the foreign country; or
(iii) be required to give evidence in any proceeding in the foreign
country;
unless –
(iv) the person has left the foreign country; or
(v) the person has had the opportunity of leaving the foreign
country and has remained in that country otherwise than for
the purpose of giving assistance in relation to the investigation
to which the request relates;
(b) That the person will be returned to Niue under arrangements agreed
by the Attorney-General;
(c) In a case where the person is being held in custody in Niue and the
Attorney-General requests the foreign country to make
arrangements for the keeping of the person in custody while the
person is in the foreign country –
(i) the making of appropriate arrangements for that purpose;
(ii) that the person will not be released from custody in the foreign
country unless the Attorney-General notifies an appropriate
authority of the foreign country that the person is entitled to
be released from custody under Niue law; and
1122 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(iii) if the person is released in the foreign country as mentioned in subparagraph (ii) that the person’s accommodation and expenses pending the completion of the investigation to which the request relates will be paid for by the foreign country; and
(d) Such other matters (if any) as the Attorney-General thinks appropriate.

26 Effect of removal to foreign country on prisoner’s term of imprisonment

Where a prisoner who is serving a term of imprisonment for an offence
against a law of Niue is released from a prison pursuant to a request by a foreign
country under section 24 or 25, the prisoner shall, while in custody in connection
with the request (including custody outside Niue), be deemed to be continuing to
serve that term of imprisonment.

27 Transit

PART 5
CUSTODY OF PERSONS IN TRANSIT
(1) If a person is to be transported in custody from a foreign country through Niue to another foreign country for the purposes of –
(a) Giving evidence in a proceeding; or
(b) Giving assistance in relation to an investigation;
relating to a criminal matter in the other foreign country, the person –
(c) May be transported through Niue in the custody of another person;
and
(d) If an aircraft or ship by which the person is being transported lands
or calls at a place in Niue, shall be kept in such custody as the
Attorney-General directs in writing until his or her transportation
is continued.
(2) Where a person who is being held in custody under a direction under
subsection (l)(d) and the person’s transportation is not, in the opinion of the
Attorney-General, continued within a reasonable time, the Attorney-General may
direct that the person be transported in custody to the foreign country from which
the person was first transported.

28 Arrest of person in transit

(1) Any constable may, without warrant, arrest a person if the constable
has reasonable grounds to believe that the person was being kept in custody under
direction under section 29(l)(d) and has escaped from that custody.
(2) The constable must, as soon as practicable, take the person before a
Commissioner.
(3) If the Commissioner is satisfied that the person has escaped from lawful
custody, the Commissioner may issue a warrant authorising any constable to return
the person to lawful custody.

29 Aiding person to escape

The laws of Niue in relation to –
(a) Aiding a prisoner to escape from custody;
(b) Rescuing a prisoner from custody;
(c) Permitting escape; and
(d) Harbouring an escapee,
apply in respect of a person who is in custody in Niue pursuant to a request to a
foreign country by Niue under this Act.

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1123
PART 6
PROCEEDS OF CRIME

Requests by Niue

30 Requests for enforcement of orders

Niue may request an appropriate authority of a foreign country to
make arrangements for the enforcement of –
(a) A forfeiture order made in Niue against property that is believed to
be located in that foreign country;
(b) A confiscation order made in Niue where some or all of the property
available to satisfy the order is believed to be located in that foreign
country; or
(c) A restraining order made in Niue against property that is believed
to be located in that foreign country;
if the order was made in respect of a serious offence.

31 Requests for issue of orders in foreign countries

Where a criminal proceeding or investigation has commenced in Niue in
relation to a serious offence, Niue may request an appropriate authority of a foreign
country to obtain the issue, in respect of the offence, of a warrant, order or other
instrument similar in nature to any of the following warrants and orders under
the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 –
(a) A search warrant for tainted property;
(b) A restraining order;
(c) A production order in respect of a property-tracking document;
(d) A search warrant in respect of a property-tracking document.

Requests by Foreign Countries

32 Requests for enforcement of orders

(1) Where –
(a) A foreign country requests the Attorney-General to make
arrangements for the enforcement of –
(i) A foreign forfeiture order, made in respect of a serious offence,
against property that is believed to be located in Niue; or
(ii) a foreign confiscation order, made in respect of a serious offence,
where some or all of the property available to satisfy the order
is believed to be located in Niue; and
(b) The Attorney-General is satisfied that –
(i) a person has been convicted of the offence; and
(ii) the conviction and the order are not subject to further appeal
in the foreign country;
the Attorney-General may apply for the registration of the order in the Court.
(2) Where a foreign country requests the Attorney-General to make
arrangements for the enforcement of a foreign restraining order, made in respect
of a serious offence, against property that is believed to be located in Niue, the
Attorney-General may apply for the registration of the order in the Court.
(3) Where the Attorney-General applies to the Court for registration of a
foreign order under this section, the Court shall register the order accordingly.
(4) A foreign forfeiture order registered in the Court under this section has
effect, and may be enforced, as if it were a forfeiture order made by the Court
under the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 at the time of registration.
1124 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
(5) A foreign confiscation order registered in the Court under this section has effect, and may be enforced, as if it were a confiscation order made by the Court under the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 at the time of registration and requiring the payment to the Crown of the amount payable under the order.
(6) A foreign restraining order registered in the Court under this section has effect, and may be enforced, as if it were a restraining order made by the Court under the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 at the time of registration.
(7) Where a foreign confiscation order or a foreign restraining order is registered in the Court under this section, a copy of any amendments made to the order (whether before or after registration) may be registered in the same way as the order and the amendments do not, for the purposes of this Act and the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998, have effect until they are registered.
(8) An order or an amendment of an order shall be registered in the Court by registration under the rules of the Court, of –
(a) A copy of the appropriate order or amendment sealed by the court
or other authority making that order or amendment; or
(b) A copy of that order or amendment duly authenticated under
section 49(2).
(9) A facsimile copy of a sealed or authenticated copy of an order or an
amendment of an order shall be regarded for the purposes of this Act as the same
as the sealed or authenticated copy but registration effected by means of the
facsimile copy ceases to have effect at the end of 42 days unless the sealed or
authenticated copy has been registered by then.
(10) The Attorney-General may apply to the Court for cancellation of the
registration of a foreign confiscation order or a foreign restraining order that has
been registered in the Court.
(11) Where the Attorney-General applies to the Court for cancellation of a
registration under subsection (10), the Court shall cancel the registration
accordingly.
(12) Section 68 of the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 does not apply to an
order registered under this section.

33 Requests for search and seizure warrants in respect of tainted property

Where –
(a) A criminal proceeding or investigation has commenced in a foreign
country in respect of a serious offence;
(b) There are reasonable grounds to believe that tainted property in
relation to the offence is located in Niue; and
(c) The foreign country requests the Attorney-General to obtain the
issue of a search warrant in relation to the tainted property;
the Attorney-General may authorise a constable to apply to a Commissioner under
the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 for a search warrant in relation to that tainted
property.

34 Requests for restraining orders

Where –
(a) A criminal proceeding has commenced, or there are reasonable
grounds to believe that a criminal proceeding is about to commence,
in a foreign country in respect of a serious offence;
(b) There are reasonable grounds to believe that property that may be
made or is about to be made the subject of a foreign restraining
order is located in Niue; and

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1125
(c) The foreign country requests the Attorney-General to obtain the issue of a restraining order against the property;
the Attorney-General may apply to the Court for a restraining order under the
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 against that property in respect of the offence.

35 Requests for information gathering orders

Where –
(a) A criminal proceeding or investigation has commenced in a foreign
country in respect of a serious offence;
(b) A property-tracking document in relation to the offence is
reasonably believed to be located in Niue; and
(c) The foreign country requests the Attorney-General to obtain the
issue of –
(i) an order requiring the documents to be produced or made
available for inspection under the law of Niue; or
(ii) a search warrant in respect of the offence,
the Attorney-General may apply to a Commissioner for a production order under the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 in respect of the offence for the purpose of obtaining possession of the property-tracking document or a search warrant under that Act in relation to the property-tracking document as the case requires.

35A Cabinet may approve proposals for sharing certain property

(1) In this section –
“qualifying property” means property –
(a) That is vested in the Government by virtue of a forfeiture order
and that can no longer be made the subject of an application under
section 13 or section 14 of the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 or section
23 of the Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006
by a person who claims to have, or to have had, an interest in the
property; or
(b) That has been paid to the Government under section 15 of the
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 (payment instead of forfeiture order);
or
(c) That has been paid to the Government under a confiscation order.
(2) The Cabinet may approve proposals for sharing specified qualifying
property with a foreign country that has provided assistance to Niue under this
Act or the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2) –
(a) The specified qualifying property need not have become property
of the Government as a result of the assistance provided by the
foreign country; and
(b) The proposals may, but need not, involve that country reciprocally
sharing with Niue property realised under laws of the foreign
country that correspond to the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998.
(4) The Attorney-General may enter into arrangements with the competent
authorities of the foreign country in order to give effect to any sharing proposal
approved by the Cabinet under subsection (2).
1126 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2
PART 7
REQUESTS BY OR ON BEHALF OF A DEFENDANT

36 Requests by Attorney-General on behalf of a defendant

(1) If a defendant in a proceeding (original proceeding) relating to a criminal
matter thinks that it is necessary for the purposes of the proceeding that –
(a) Evidence should be taken in a foreign country; or
(b) A document or other article in a foreign country should be produced;
or
(c) A thing located in a foreign country should be seized; or
(d) Arrangements should be made for a person who is in a foreign
country to come to Niue (under a request to a foreign country by
Niue under this Act) to give evidence relevant to the proceeding,
the defendant may apply to the Court for a certificate that it would be in the
interests of justice for the Attorney-General to make any appropriate request to
the foreign country under Part 2, 3 or 4 so that –
(i) The evidence may be taken; or
(ii) The document or article may be produced; or
(iii) The thing may be seized; or
(iv) The arrangements may be made.
(2) Before making a decision on the application, the Court must give an
opportunity to –
(a) All parties to the original proceeding; and
(b) The Attorney-General,
to appear before the Court and be heard on the merits of the application.
(3) In deciding whether to issue a certificate, the Court must have regard
to the following matters –
(a) Whether the foreign country is likely to grant such a request made
by the Attorney-General on behalf of the defendant;
(b) The extent to which the material (whether it is evidence, a document,
an article or a thing) that the defendant seeks to obtain from the
foreign country would not otherwise be available;
(c) Whether the court hearing the original proceeding would be likely
to admit the material into evidence in the proceeding;
(d) The likely probative value of the material, if it were admitted into
evidence in the proceeding, with respect to any issue likely to be
determined in the proceeding;
(e) Whether the defendant would be unfairly prejudiced if the material
were not available to the Court.
(4) Subsection (3) does not prevent the Court from having regard to any
other matter that it considers relevant.
(5) If the Court issues a certificate –
(a) The Court must, send a copy of the certificate to the Attorney-
General; and
(b) The Attorney-General must in accordance with the certificate, make
a request on behalf of the defendant to the foreign country, for
international assistance unless he or she is of the opinion, having
regard to the special circumstances of the case, that the request
should not be made.

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1127

37 Certificate by Attorney-General if foreign country refuses request made under section 36

(1) If a foreign country refuses a request made under section 36(5), the
Attorney-General must give a certificate in writing to that effect.
(2) A certificate under subsection (1) is prima facie evidence of the facts
stated in it.

38 Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 8
ADMISSIBILITY OF FOREIGN EVIDENCE

Preliminary

“civil proceeding” means a proceeding other than a criminal proceeding; “criminal proceeding” includes –
(a) A prosecution for an offence;
(b) A proceeding for the committal of a person for trial for an offence;
and
(c) A proceeding for the sentencing of a person convicted of an offence;
“foreign law” means a law (whether written or unwritten) of, or in force
in, a country other than Niue;
“foreign material” means –
(a) The testimony of a person that –
(i) was obtained as a result of a request of a kind referred to in
section 40; and
(ii) complies with the requirements of section 42; and
(b) Any exhibit annexed to any such testimony; and
(c) Any part of any such testimony or exhibit;
“Niue court” means –
(a) The Court; or
(b) A Commissioner; or arbitrator acting under Niue law; or
(c) A person or body authorised by a Niue law, or by consent of parties,
to hear, receive and examine evidence;
“related civil proceedings”, in relation to a criminal proceeding, means any
civil proceedings arising from the same subject-matter from which the
criminal proceeding arose.

39 Proceedings to which this Part applies

This Part applies to a proceeding, before a Niue court, that is –
(a) A criminal proceeding for an offence against the law of Niue; or
(b) A related civil proceeding.

Obtaining Foreign Material

40 Requests for foreign material

This Part applies to –
(a) Testimony, obtained as a result of a request made by or on behalf of
the Attorney-General to a foreign country for the testimony of a
person; and
(b) Any exhibit annexed to any such testimony.
1128 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

41 Requirements for testimony

(1) The testimony must be taken before a court –
(a) On oath or affirmation; or
(b) Under such caution or admonition as would be accepted, by courts
in the foreign country concerned, for the purposes of giving
testimony in proceedings before those courts.
(2) The testimony may be taken in camera.

42 Form of testimony

(1) The testimony may be recorded in any of the following manners –
(a) In writing;
(b) On audio tape;
(c) On video tape.
(2) The testimony need not –
(a) Be in the form of an affidavit; or
(b) Constitute a transcript of a proceeding in a foreign court.
(3) The testimony must be endorsed with, or be accompanied by, a
certificate to the effect that –
(a) It is an accurate record of the evidence given; and
(b) It was taken in the manner specified by section 41.
(4) The certificate must –
(a) Purport to be signed or certified by a judge, magistrate or court
officer of the foreign country to which the request was made; and
(b) Purport to bear an official or public seal of –
(i) the country; or
(ii) an authority of the country responsible for matters relating to
justice, being a Minister of State, a Ministry or Department of
Government, or an officer of the Government.

Using Foreign Material

43 Foreign material may be adduced as evidence

(1) Subject to subsection (2) and to section 44, foreign material may be
adduced as evidence in a proceeding to which this Part applies.
(2) The foreign material is not to be adduced as evidence if –
(a) At the hearing of the proceeding, it appears to the Court’s
satisfaction that the person who gave the testimony concerned is
present in Niue and is able to testify at the hearing; or
(b) The evidence would not have been admissible had it been adduced
from the person at the hearing.

44 Direction to prevent foreign material being adduced

(1) The Court may direct that foreign material not be adduced as evidence
if it appears to the Court’s satisfaction that the interests of justice would be better
served if the foreign material were not adduced as evidence.
(2) Without limiting the matters that the Court may take into account in
deciding whether to give such a direction, it must take into account –
(a) The extent to which the foreign material provides evidence which
would not otherwise be available; and
(b) The probative value of the foreign material with respect to any issue
that is likely to be determined in the proceedings; and
(c) The extent to which statements contained in the foreign material
could, at the time they were made, be challenged by questioning
the persons who made them; and

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1129
(d) Whether exclusion of the foreign material would cause undue expense or delay; and
(e) Whether exclusion of the foreign material would prejudice – (i) the defence in criminal proceedings; or
(ii) any party to related civil proceedings.

Miscellaneous

45 Certificates relating to foreign material

(1) The Attorney-General may certify that specified foreign material was
obtained as a result of a request made to a foreign country by or on behalf of the
Attorney-General.
(2) It is presumed (unless evidence sufficient to raise reasonable doubt is
adduced to the contrary) that the foreign material specified in the certificate was
obtained as a result of that request.

46 Effect of Part on right to examine witnesses

(1) Subject to this section, nothing in this Part shall be taken to limit the
right of the defendant in any criminal proceedings to which this Part applies (in
this section referred to as “the defendant”) to examine in person or by his legal
representative any witness whose testimony is admitted in evidence in those
proceedings.
(2) If the defendant requests that the person who gave the testimony
concerned be present at the hearing in Niue for the purposes of cross-examination,
the court shall warn the defendant that he may be ordered to pay any expenses
incurred by the Crown in making the person available before the Court.
(a) As a result of the request, the person appears before the Court as a
witness; and
(b) It appears to the court that the cross-examination of the person was
unnecessary, of a trivial nature or irrelevant to the matters in issue
in the proceedings,
the Court may order that the defendant pay any expenses incurred by the Crown
in obtaining the attendance of the person as a witness.
(4) A certificate signed by the Attorney-General shall be evidence of the
expenses incurred by the Crown for the purposes of subsection (3).
(5) An amount payable by a person to the Crown under an order under
subsection (3) is a civil debt due by the person to the Crown.
(6) An order against a person under subsection (3) may be enforced as if it
were an order made in civil proceedings instituted by the Crown against the person
to recover a debt due by the person to the Crown and the debt arising from the
order shall be taken to be a judgment debt.

47 Operation of other laws

This Part does not limit the ways in which a matter may be proved, or
evidence may be adduced, under any other Niue law.

48 Delegation

PART 9
MISCELLANEOUS
The Attorney-General may, delegate to an officer of the Attorney-General’s
Department all or any of his or her powers under this Act.
1130 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

49 Authentication of documents

(1) In a proceeding under this Act or a proceeding under or pursuant to
the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 arising directly or indirectly from a request made
under this Act, any document that is duly authenticated is admissible in evidence.
(2) A document is duly authenticated for the purposes of subsection (1)
if –
(a) It purports to be signed or certified by a judge, magistrate or officer in or of a foreign country; and
(b) It purports to be sealed with an official or public seal of the foreign country or of a Minister of State, or of a Department or officer of the Government, of the foreign country.
(3) Nothing in this section prevents the proof of any matter, or the
admission in evidence of any document, in accordance with any other law of Niue.

50 Restriction on use of information

(1) If, as a result of a request made by the Attorney-General under this Act,
any material (whether it is evidence, a document, an article or a thing) has been
sent to Niue by a foreign country for the purposes of a proceeding or investigation
in relation to a criminal matter, the material is not to be used intentionally for any
other purpose without the approval of the Attorney-General.
(2) The material is inadmissible in evidence in any proceeding other than
the proceeding in respect of which it was obtained unless the Attorney-General
has approved its use for the purposes of that other proceeding.
(3) Any information, document, article or thing obtained directly or
indirectly from a person by making use of the material –
(a) Otherwise than for the purpose of the proceeding or investigation
in respect of which it was obtained; and
(b) Without the approval of the Attorney-General;
is inadmissible in evidence in any other proceeding and may not be used for the
purposes of any other investigation.
(4) A person who contravenes subsection (1) is guilty of an offence
punishable, on conviction, by –
(a) If the person is a natural person, a fine not exceeding 120 penalty
units or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 2 years, or both;
or
(b) If the person is a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 600 penalty
units.
(5) For the purposes of this section, disclosure of any material is taken to
be a use of that material.

51 Requests for international assistance not to be disclosed

(1) A person who, because of his or her office or employment, has
knowledge of
(a) The contents of a request for international assistance made by a
foreign country to Niue under this Act; or
(b) The fact that such a request has been made; or
(c) That fact that such a request has been granted or refused,
must not intentionally disclose those contents or that fact except if –
(d) It is necessary to do so in the performance of his or her duties; or
(e) The Attorney-General has given his or her approval to the disclosure
of those contents or that fact.

Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998

1131
(2) A person who contravenes subsection (1) is guilty of an offence punishable, on conviction, by –
(a) If the person is a natural person, a fine not exceeding 120 penalty units or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 2 years, or both; or
(b) If the person is a body corporate, a fine not exceeding 600 penalty
units.

52 Regulations

The Cabinet may make regulations, not inconsistent with this Act,
prescribing matters –
(a) Required or permitted by this Act to be prescribed; or
(b) Necessary or convenient to be prescribed for carrying out or giving
effect to this Act,
and, in particular, prescribing the practice and procedure in relation to the
performance by Commissioners of functions under this Act, including the
summoning of witnesses, the production of documents, the taking of evidence on
oath, the administering of oaths, the payment of expenses and allowances of
witnesses and the protection and immunity of Commissioners, of barristers and
solicitors appearing before Commissioners and of witnesses.

1132 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 2

Niue Laws (Volume 3)

NIUE LAWS

TAU FAKATUFONO-TOHI A NIUE

LEGISLATION AS AT DECEMBER 2006

VOLUME 3 TOHI 3

STATUTES

N – Z

GOVERNMENT OF NIUE, ALOFI

2006

Copyright 2006 All rights reserved

Enquiries concerning the copyright material

should be addressed to the

Crown Law Office, Alofi, Niue

Printed by Stylex Print, Palmerston North, New Zealand

VOLUME THREE

National Disaster Relief Fund Act 1980 ............................................................... 1133
New Zealand Representative Act 1981 ................................................................ 1135
Niue Act 1966 .......................................................................................................... 1139
Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 ....................................................................... 1231
Niue Assembly Act 1966 ........................................................................................ 1253
Niue Bank Act 1994 ................................................................................................ 1297
Niue Certification Authority Act 1978 ................................................................. 1333
Niue Cultural Council Act 1986 ............................................................................ 1335
Niue Development Bank Act 1993 ....................................................................... 1339
Niue Development Bonds Act 1994 ..................................................................... 1355
Niue Flag Act 1975 .................................................................................................. 1365
Niue Philatelic and Numismatic Act 1996 .......................................................... 1367
Niue Trust Fund Act 2004 ...................................................................................... 1371
Occupiers’ Liability Act 1962 ................................................................................ 1373
Partnership Act 1908 .............................................................................................. 1377
Partnership Application Act 1994 ......................................................................... 1391
Pensions and Benefits Act 1991 ............................................................................. 1399
Pesticides Act 1991 .................................................................................................. 1405
Pig Control Act 1998 ............................................................................................... 1411
Price Control on Imported Goods for Resale in Niue Act 1975 ....................... 1417
Proceeds of Crime Act 1998 ................................................................................... 1421
Property Law Act 1952 ........................................................................................... 1459
Public Emergency Act 1979 ................................................................................... 1487
Public Health Act 1965 ........................................................................................... 1491
Public Notaries Act 1998 ........................................................................................ 1511
Public Revenues Act 1959 ...................................................................................... 1513
Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980 ............................................ 1525
Race Relations Act 1972 ......................................................................................... 1535
Reprint of Statutes Act 1991 .................................................................................. 1543
Royal Titles Act 1974 .............................................................................................. 1545
Sale of Goods Act 1908 ........................................................................................... 1547
Seal of New Zealand Act 1977 .............................................................................. 1563
Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996 .................................... 1565
Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006 ............................ 1587
Tourist Authority Act 1995 .................................................................................... 1607
Transport Act 1965 .................................................................................................. 1615
Trustee Act 1956 ...................................................................................................... 1651
Trustee Companies Act 1995 ................................................................................. 1699
Trusts Act 1994 ........................................................................................................ 1701
United Nations Act 1946 ........................................................................................ 1729
Village Councils Act 1967 ...................................................................................... 1731
Visiting Forces Act 1939 ......................................................................................... 1747
Water Resources Act 1996 ...................................................................................... 1753
Wildlife Act 1972 ..................................................................................................... 1767
Wills Act 1837 .......................................................................................................... 1771
Wills Act Amendment Act 1852 ............................................................................ 1779
Wreck and Salvage Act 1968 .................................................................................. 1781
1133

NATIONAL DISASTER RELIEF FUND ACT 1980

1980/61 – 10 November 1980

1

Short title

6

Investment of moneys of the Fund

2

Interpretation

7

Expenditure of moneys of the Fund

3

National Disaster Relief Fund established

8

Annual accounts and audit

4

General objects of the Fund

9

Annual report

5

National Disaster Relief Fund Account

10

Delegated authority

To establish and control a fund to be used to repair damage suffered by public property during national disasters and to provide assistance to victims of such national disasters

1 Short title

This is the National Disaster Relief Fund Act 1980.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Fund” means the National Disaster Relief Fund;
“national disaster” means any storm, tempest, cyclone, flood, earth tremor,
drought, fire, disease or act of God from any cause whatsoever as
declared a national disaster by Cabinet and includes any public
emergency proclaimed under the Public Emergency Act 1979.

3 National Disaster Relief Fund established

(1) There is hereby established a fund to be called the National Disaster
Relief Fund.
(2) The resources of the Fund shall consist of the following –
(a) Contributions by the Government of Niue and other governments;
(b) Contributions by private organisations whether domestic or
international with contributions by private individuals;
(c) Returns from investments made from the Fund.

4 General objects of the Fund

The general objects for which moneys in the Fund may be applied are –
(a) The repair of damage suffered to public property during a national
disaster;
(b) The immediate provision of financial and other assistance to victims
of national disasters.
1134 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

5 National Disaster Relief Fund Account

There is hereby established a Fund account with the Treasury Department
of Niue to be called the National Disaster Relief Fund Account and all of the Fund’s
moneys shall be paid into the Fund Account.

6 Investment of moneys of the Fund

The Financial Secretary may invest any moneys of the Fund in accordance
with laws, rules and regulations for the time being in force in Niue regarding
investments of public funds.

7 Expenditure of moneys of the Fund

Subject to section 6, no moneys shall be paid out of the Fund Account except
with the approval of the Financial Secretary acting within the objects specified in
section 4 for the specific purposes and in the manner approved by Cabinet.

8 Annual accounts and audit

(1) At the close of each financial year the Financial Secretary shall cause to
be prepared in respect of the Fund a revenue and expenditure account for that
year together with a balance sheet showing the assets and liabilities of the Fund.
(2) That account and balance sheet shall be audited as prescribed by article
60 of the Constitution.

9 Annual report

The Financial Secretary shall in each financial year cause to be prepared a
report of the Fund’s operations during the preceding year and such report together
with the audited statements and balance sheet mentioned in section 8 shall be laid
before the Assembly at its first session after the audited statements and balance
sheet are available and shall receive such publicity as the Assembly directs.

10 Delegated authority

(1) Where Cabinet has delegated all or any of its authority in times of public
emergency or national disaster to persons other than Cabinet under section 3 of
the Public Emergency Act 1979 those persons shall have full authority under section
7 of this Act to approve the expenditure of moneys from the Fund, as if such
expenditure was approved by Cabinet itself.
(2) Any such expenditure from the Fund and circumstances of that
approval shall be brought to the notice of the Cabinet by the Premier at the earliest
possible opportunity.
1135

NEW ZEALAND REPRESENTATIVE ACT 1981

1981/69 – 1 August 1981

1

Short title

8

Premier may determine fiscal privileges

2

Interpretation

9

Proof of status

3

The Government of New Zealand

10

Privileges and immunities

4

Office of the New Zealand Representative

11-12

[Spent]

5

Diplomatic staff

6

Members of families of diplomatic staff

SCHEDULE

7

Other staff members and their families

Relating to the legal status of the representative of the Government of New

Zealand in Niue and of designated members of his staff and their families

1 Short title

This is the New Zealand Representative Act 1981.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“diplomatic courier of the Government of New Zealand” means a person
(not being ordinarily resident in Niue) to whom the Government of
New Zealand has for the time being provided an official document
indicating –
(a) His status as a diplomatic courier of the Government of New
Zealand; and
(b) The number of packages constituting each bag carried by him and
used for the official correspondence of the Government of New
Zealand;
“diplomatic staff of the Office of the New Zealand Representative” means
the New Zealand Representative, and those members of the staff of his
office who for the time being hold any of the positions specified in the
Schedule;
“New Zealand Representative” means the person who is for the time being
recognised by the Government of Niue as the representative of the
Government of New Zealand in Niue;
“1968 Act” means the Diplomatic Privileges and Immunities Act 1968.
(2) In this Act a reference to a person ordinarily resident in Niue shall
include a reference to –
(a) Any person belonging to that part of the Polynesian race indigenous
to Niue; and
(b) Any person for the time being living in Niue otherwise than for the
sole purpose of –
1136 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
Act –
(i) performing his duties as a member of the Office of the New
Zealand Representative; and
(ii) being a member of family forming part of the household of a
person referred to in sub-paragraph (i).
(3) For the purposes of this Act, every reference in the Schedule to the 1968
(a) To the sending state shall be construed as a reference to New
Zealand;
(b) To the receiving state or to the country shall be construed as a
reference to Niue;
(c) To a national of the receiving state shall be construed as a reference
to a person who is ordinarily resident in Niue;
(d) To the Ministry of Foreign Affairs shall be construed as a reference
to the Office of the Secretary to the Government of Niue;
(e) To the head of mission shall be construed as a reference to the New
Zealand Representative;
(f) To the mission shall be construed as a reference to the Office of the
New Zealand Representative.

3 The Government of New Zealand

The Government of New Zealand shall be accorded the same privileges
and immunities as are accorded to a sending state by the 1968 Act.

4 Office of the New Zealand Representative

(1) The office of the New Zealand Representative shall be accorded the
same privileges and immunities as are accorded to a diplomatic mission by the
1968 Act.
(2) (a) The premises, furnishings, means of transport and other property
of the Office of the New Zealand Representative; and
(b) The archives and documents of the Office of the New Zealand
Representative; and
(c) The official correspondence of the New Zealand Representative;
and
(d) Articles for the official use of the Office of the New Zealand
Representative,
shall be accorded the same privileges and immunities as the case requires as are
accorded to those of a diplomatic mission by the 1968 Act.
(3) Without limiting the generality of section 3 and subsections (1) and (2)
of this section –
(a) The 1968 Act shall apply to every bag used for the official
correspondence of the Government of New Zealand as if it were a
diplomatic bag referred to in that Act; and
(b) Every diplomatic courier of the Government of New Zealand shall
be accorded the same personal inviolability, protection, and
immunity as are accorded to diplomatic couriers under the 1968
Act.

New Zealand Representative Act 1981

1137

5 Diplomatic staff

(1) Every member of the diplomatic staff of the office of the New Zealand
Representative shall be accorded the same privileges and immunities as are
accorded to a diplomatic agent by the 1968 Act.
(2) The private residence of every member of the diplomatic staff of the
Office of the New Zealand Representative shall be accorded the same privileges
and immunities as are accorded to that of a diplomatic agent under the 1968 Act.
(3) The papers, correspondence, property and articles for the personal use
of each member of the diplomatic staff of the Office of the New Zealand
Representative shall be accorded the same privileges and immunities as the case
requires as are accorded to those of a diplomatic agent under the 1968 Act.

6 Members of families of diplomatic staff

Every person, being a member of the family and forming part of the
household of a member of the diplomatic staff of the Office of the New Zealand
Representative and not in any case being ordinarily resident in Niue shall be
accorded the same privileges and immunities as are accorded to members of the
diplomatic staff of that office by section 5.

7 Other staff members and their families

(1) Every person who is –
(a) A member of the administrative or technical staff of the Office of
the New Zealand Representative; or
(b) A member of the family, forming part of the household of a member
of the administrative or technical staff of the Office of the New
Zealand Representative; or
(c) A member of the service staff of the Office of the New Zealand
Representative –
not in any case being ordinarily resident in Niue shall be accorded the same
privileges and immunities as the case requires as would be accorded to that person
under the 1968 Act if that office were a diplomatic mission.
(2) Every person, being a member of the administrative, technical, or service
staff of the Office of the New Zealand representative who is ordinarily resident in
Niue, shall be accorded immunity from jurisdiction and inviolability in respect of
official acts performed in the exercise of his functions.

8 Premier may determine fiscal privileges

Without prejudice to sections 3 to 7, the Premier with the concurrence of
Cabinet, may determine, either generally or in any case or class of case, the fiscal
privileges which shall be accorded to the Office of the New Zealand Representative
or persons connected with that Office notwithstanding that the determination
may extend treatment more favourable than that required by this Act, and may in
like manner determine the terms and conditions on which these privileges may
be enjoyed.

9 Proof of status

If in any proceeding any question arises as to whether or not any person is
or was at any time or in respect of any period accorded any privilege, or immunity,
under or by virtue of this Act, a certificate issued by the Secretary to the
Government stating any fact relevant to that question shall be conclusive evidence
of that fact.
1138 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

10 Privileges and immunities

Subject to this Act, privileges and immunities conferred by or by virtue of
this Act shall be conferred on the same terms and conditions as to commencement
and cessation, and as to waiver, as are provided in the 1968 Act.

11-12 [Spent]

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
DIPLOMATIC STAFF OF THE OFFICE OF THE NEW ZEALAND REPRESENTATIVE
Deputy New Zealand Representative
Minister
Counsellor
First Secretary
Second Secretary
Third Secretary
Attache
1139

NIUE ACT 1966

1966/38 (NZ) – 1 January 1967

1 Short title

2-3 [Repealed]

71 Procedure so far as not governed by rules of Court

4–14D [Repealed]

15-20 [Repealed]

21 Persons authorised to practise medicine

or surgery

22 Offences

23 Director of Health

23A Medical services

24-25 [Repealed]

26 Establishment of prisons

27 Detention of persons in custody

28 Labour instead of imprisonment

29 [Repealed]

29A Prisons and criminal justice

30 [Repealed]

PART 2

THE LEGISLATIVE GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

31-48 [Repealed]

49 Regulations

50-52 [Repealed]

PART 3

THE HIGH COURT OF NIUE

Constitution of the High Court

53-59 [Repealed]

60 Commissioners of High Court

61 [Repealed]

62 Registrar and Deputy Registrar of the

High Court

63 [Repealed]

64 Seal of the High Court

65 Records of the High Court

Jurisdiction of the High Court

66-67 [Repealed]

68 Habeas corpus

69 Custody of minors

Procedure of the High Court

70 Rules of Court

75

76

77

78

79

80

81

82

83

84

85

86

87

88

89

90

91

92

93

94

95

96

96A

97

98

99

100

101

102

103

104

105

Commissioners to take evidence

Evidence by affidavit sworn out of

Niue

Witnesses may be ordered out of Court

Affidavits in Niue

Evidence by affidavit

Right of audience in the High Court

Costs

Security for costs

Court fees

Minutes of judgments

Amendments

Rehearing of civil proceedings

Rehearing of criminal proceedings

Execution of Judgments Writs of sale and possession Effect of writ of possession Effect of writ of sale

Issue of writs of sale or possession

Charging orders

Stay of execution

Judgment summons

Enforcement of foreign judgments

Absconding Debtors

Order of arrest of absconding debtor

Commissioner and Justices’ authority

Security to be given

Enforcement of security

Arrest in actions for penalties

Enforcement of security in actions for

penalties

Contempt of the High Court Contempt of Court defined Penalty for contempt Jurisdiction in contempt

Contempt in the face of the Court

Discharge of persons in contempt

1140 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 4

THE HIGH COURT

106 [Repealed]

107 Declarations

108 [Repealed]

109 Cases stated

110 [Repealed]

Appeals from the High Court

111-112 [Repealed]

113 Transmission of record

114 Dismissal of appeal for non-

prosecution

115 Procedure on appeal

116 [Repealed]

117 Powers of Court of Appeal

118 Evidence on appeal

119 Stay of execution

120 Release of appellant from custody

121 Appeal not to be allowed for

irregularities

122 Right of audience on appeal

123 Transmission of order of Court of

Appeal

124-125 [Repealed]

Enforcement in Niue of Judgments of New Zealand Courts

126 Judgments of High Court or a District Court in New Zealand may be enforced by the High Court

127 Enforcement of judgments of the High Court of New Zealand by High Court by way of proceedings for contempt

128 [Repealed]

PART 5

CRIMINAL OFFENCES

129 Seditious offences

130 Punishment of seditious offences

131 Homicide

132 Killing of a child

133 Culpable homicide

134 Murder

135 Further definition of murder

136 Provocation

137 Illegal arrest may be evidence of

provocation

138 Punishment of murder

139 Manslaughter

140 Punishment of manslaughter

141 Omissions dangerous to life

142 Duty to provide the necessaries of life

143 Duty of parent or guardian to provide

necessaries

144 Liability for dangerous things

145 Hastening death

146 Indirect cause of death

147 Attempted murder

148 Conspiracy and inciting to murder

149 Counselling suicide

150 Concealment of birth

151 Grievous bodily harm

152 Actual bodily harm

153 Omissions resulting in bodily harm

154 Intentionally endangering persons on

aerodromes

155 Wantonly endangering persons on

aerodromes

156 Indecent assault

157 Assault

157A Cruelty to a child

158 Resisting constable in execution of his

duty

159 Abduction of girl under 15

160 Abduction of children

161 Sexual intercourse

162 Rape

163 Sexual intercourse or indecency with

girl under 12

164 Sexual intercourse or indecency with

girl between 12 and 15

165 Sexual intercourse with woman or girl

who is an idiot or imbecile or of

unsound mind

166 Procuring miscarriage of woman or girl

167 Act of woman or girl procuring her

own miscarriage

168 Supplying means of miscarriage

169 Bigamy

170 Buggery

171 Attempted buggery and indecent

assaults on males

172 Incest

173 Indecent acts

174 Indecent documents

175 Brothels

176 Gaming houses

176A Powers to permit gambling

177 Riot

178 Forcible entry

179 Affrays

CRIMES AFFECTING THE ADMINISTRATION OF LAW AND JUSTICE

Bribery and Corruption

180 Interpretation

180A Judicial corruption

180B Bribery of judicial officer

180C Corruption and bribery of Minister

180D Corruption and bribery of member of

Assembly

Niue Act 1966 1141

180E Corruption and bribery of law enforcement officer

180F Corruption and bribery of official

180G Corrupt use of official information

180H Restrictions on prosecutions

181 Perjury

182 Fabricating evidence

183 Conspiracy to pervert justice

184 Breaking prison

185 Escape

186 Rescue

187 Criminal libel or slander

188 Definition of theft

189 Ineffectual defences to charge of theft

190 Extended definition of theft

191 Obtaining money or goods by false

pretences

192 Punishment of theft

193 Stealing documents

194 Receiving stolen goods

195 Robbery

196 Conversion or attempted conversion

197 Breach of trust

198 Menaces

199 Witchcraft

200 Obtaining credit by fraud

201 Accusation of criminal offences

202 Conspiracy to defraud

203 Obtaining execution of valuable

securities by fraud

204 Burglary

205 Unlawful entry of dwellinghouse

205A Entering premises for a criminal

purpose

206 Threats to kill or do bodily harm

207 Forgery

208 Extended definition of forgery

209 Making counterfeit coin

210 Lightening coin

211 Uttering counterfeit coin

212 Arson

213 Wilful mischief to property

214 Provoking breach of the peace

215 Profane, indecent, or obscene language

216 Disorderly conduct in public places

217 Obstructing public place

218 Drunkenness

219 Animal trespass

220 Prostitution

221 Laying poison

222 Polluting water

223 Sale of unwholesome provisions

224 Insanitary premises

225 Wilful trespass

226 Cruelty to animals

227 Falsely trading as a company

228 Conspiracy

228A Wrongful communication, retention or

copying of official information

Attempts

229 Attempts to commit offences

230 Attempt proved when offence is

charged

231 Offence proved when attempt is

charged

Parties to Offences

232 Inciting

233 Parties to offences

234 Common criminal purpose

235 Counselling or procuring

236 Accessory after the fact

237 Punishment of accessories

Infancy

237A Children under 10

237B Children between 10 and 14

Defences

238 Common law defences

239 Common law offences

Sentences

240 Power to fine instead of or in addition

to imprisonment

241 Enforcement of fines

242 Imprisonment in Niue

243 Transfer of convicted persons to New

Zealand

244 Release of prisoners transferred to New

Zealand

244A Recall of offender subject to supervision

245 Person conditionally released from

imprisonment

246 Cumulative sentences

PART 6

CRIMINAL PROCEDURE

247 [Repealed]

248 Jurisdiction of High Court

249 [Repealed]

Preliminary Proceedings

250 Arrest without warrant

251 Arrest on warrant of Commissioner

251A Duty of persons arresting

252 Committal for trial

Trial by the High Court

253 Information

254 Warrant or summons

1142 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

255 Warrant after issue of summons

255A Arrested person may be released on

bail

256 Prisoners brought before Court before

commencement of prosecution

257 Remand

258 Trial of accused in his absence

Assessors

259 Constitution of Court in criminal trials

260 Judge with assessors

261 Judge without assessors

262 Judge with or without assessors as he

thinks fit

263 Order appointing assessors

264 Number and qualifications of assessors

265 Default of assessors

266 Remuneration of assessors

267 Oath of assessors

268 Change of assessors

269 Discharge of assessors and new trial

270 Concurrence of assessors

271 Concurrence of Judge

272 Sentence

273 Concurrence of assessors necessary for

conviction

Miscellaneous Provisions

274 Alternative and cumulative charges

275 Relation between information and

conviction

276 Withdrawal of information

277 Drawing up of conviction

278 Defects of information, summons, or

warrant

279 Payment of witnesses

280 Court may order convicted person to

come up for sentence

281 Conviction without sentence or

discharge without conviction

282 Bail

283 [Repealed]

284 Search warrants

284A Power to enter premises to arrest

offender or prevent offence

285-286 [Repealed]

286A Parole Board

287 Compensation for loss of property

PART 7

LAW OF EVIDENCE

288 Definitions

289 Discretionary power to admit or reject

evidence

290 All witnesses competent

291 Evidence of parties and their spouses

292 Evidence of accused persons and their spouses

293 Cross-examination as to credit

294 Criminating questions

295 Evidence of prisoners

296 Judicial notice of enactments

297 Judicial notice of seals

298 Power to administer oaths

299 Form of oath

300 Absence of religious belief

301 Affirmation may be made instead of

oath

302 Form of affirmation

303 Evidence of children without oath

304 Necessity of oath

PART 8

EXTRADITION

Extradition from Niue to New Zealand or to the

Cook Islands

305 Arrest in Niue of fugitive offenders

from New Zealand or the Cook Islands

306 Order of return to New Zealand or to

the Cook Islands

307 Refusal of order in case of hardship

308 Imprisonment or release pending

return

309 Release on security instead of return

310 [Repealed]

311 Cancellation of order of return

Extradition from New Zealand to Niue

312 Arrest in New Zealand of fugitive

offenders from Niue

313 Order of return to Niue

314 Judicial notice of signature to warrant

315 Refusal of order in case of hardship

316 Imprisonment or release pending

return

317 Release on security instead of return

318 Return to Niue in custody

319 Cancellation of order of return

Application of Extradition Act to Niue

320 Extradition Act in force in Niue

PART 9

321-322 [Repealed]

PART 10

323-334 [Repealed]

PART 11

335-385 [Repealed]

Niue Act 1966 1143

PART 12

386-404 [Repealed]

PART 13

405-414 [Repealed]

PART 14

415-430 [Repealed]

PART 15

431-460 [Repealed]

PART 16

LAND DEVELOPMENT

461 Application of this Part

462 Cabinet may cultivate land on behalf

of owners

463 Disposal of revenues received by

Cabinet

464 Money to be paid out of or into Niue

Government Account

465 [Repealed]

466 Interference and obstruction prohibited

467 [Repealed]

PART 17

468-483 [Repealed]

property

512 Enforcement of trusts

513 Co-trustees must act jointly

514 Remuneration of trustees

PART 21

MARRIAGE

515 Prohibited degrees of consanguinity or

affinity

516 Marriages to take place before Marriage

Officer

517-518 [Repealed]

519 Offence

520 Notice of marriage

521 Mode of solemnisation

522 Record of marriage

523 Signature of record

524 Transmission of record

525 Minimum age of marriage

526 Marriage of minors

527 Offence by Marriage Officer

528 Signature of false record by party or

witness

529 Misrepresentation as to facts to procure

marriage

PART 22

DIVORCE

PART 18

484-488 [Repealed]

PART 19

NIUEAN SUCCESSION

489 Wills of Niueans

490 Succession to deceased Niueans

491 Niuean land not to vest in

administrator

492-496 [Repealed]

497 Niuean land not assets for payment of

debts

498-499 [Repealed]

PART 20

TRUSTEES FOR NIUEANS

500 Definition of “person under disability”

501 Trustee orders

502 Matters to be set forth in trustee orders

503 Appointment of new trustees

504 Orders restricting powers of trustees

505 Cancellation of trustee orders

506 Determination of trustee orders

507 Trust property not to vest in trustee

508 Administration of property by trustee

509 Alienation of property by trustee

510 Powers of trustee

511 Expenditure of revenues of trust

530 [Repealed]

531 Nullity of marriage

532 [Repealed]

533 Domicile of a married woman

534 Grounds of divorce and jurisdiction of

High Court

535 Grounds of refusal of divorce

536 Discretion to refuse decree in certain

cases

537 Co-respondent as a party

538 [Repealed]

539 Agreement no bar to divorce

540 No appeal to Court of Appeal

541-542 [Repealed]

543 Order for maintenance of divorced wife

544 Order as to custody of children

545 Molestation of divorced wife by her

husband

546 [Repealed]

PART 23

MAINTENANCE AND AFFILIATION

547 Interpretation

548 [Repealed]

549 Applications

550 [Repealed]

551 Affiliation orders

552 Evidence

1144 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

553 Maintenance order in favour of illegitimate child

554 Maintenance order against father in favour of child

555 Maintenance order against mother in favour of child

556 Maintenance order against husband

557 Maintenance order against wife

558 Maintenance order against any person

in favour of father or mother

559 Disobedience to maintenance order

560 Maintenance money a debt

561 Order in favour of non-residents

562 Order against non-residents

563 Orders in absentia

564 Repeated applications

565 Payments not to be made in advance

566 Cancellation, variation, and suspension

of orders

567 Payment of maintenance money

568 Security for obedience to maintenance

orders

569 Operation of agreements

570 Purport and duration of maintenance

orders

571 Order for past maintenance

Offences

572 Leaving Niue while maintenance

money in arrear

573 Leaving Niue after affiliation order and

before birth of child

574 Leaving Niue with intent to disobey

maintenance order

575 Leaving Niue while failing to maintain

wife

576 Leaving Niue while failing to maintain

child

577 Leaving Niue with intent to desert wife

or child

578 [Repealed]

579 Evidence of intent

PART 24

580-592 [Repealed]

PART 25

593-599 [Repealed]

PART 26

PERSONS OF UNSOUND MIND

Orders of Medical Custody

600 Application by Medical Officer to

Court

601 Medical certificates as to persons of

unsound mind

602 Order of medical custody

603 Renewal of order

604 Cancellation of order

605 [Repealed]

606 Arrest and detention of persons

committed to medical custody

607 [Repealed]

608 Removal from Niue to New Zealand

609 Conditions of removal

610 Method of removal

611 Admission to hospital of persons

removed to New Zealand

612 [Repealed]

613 No committee of estate of person of

unsound mind

614 Warrant for arrest of persons of

unsound mind

615 Arrest without warrant of persons of

unsound mind

615A Commissioner and Justices may act for

Judge

Persons of Unsound Mind Charged with Offences

616 Insane persons not to be tried for

offences

617 Accused persons acquitted on ground

of insanity

618 Discharge

619 Orders of medical custody

620 The defence of insanity in criminal

prosecutions

PART 27

621-633 [Repealed]

PART 28

634-644 [Repealed]

PART 29

NIUEAN ANTIQUITIES

645 Interpretation

646 [Repealed]

647 Niuean antiquities to be offered for sale

before exportation

648 Power to detain Niuean antiquities

attempted to be exported

649 Exporting Niuean antiquities without

permission

650 Power to remove antiquities in certain

cases

651 Right to copy of antiquities intended to

be exported

652 Cabinet to decide what articles come

under this Part

653 [Repealed]

Niue Act 1966 1145

PART 30

CUSTOMS

654-655A [Repealed]

656 Goods may be imported from New

Zealand or Cook Islands free of duty

657-658 [Repealed]

PART 31

659-671 [Repealed]

PART 32

THE LAWS OF NIUE: GENERAL PROVISIONS

Application of the Laws of New Zealand

672–677 [Repealed]

678 Criminal procedure in Niue

679-689 [Repealed]

689A Misuse of Drugs Act in force in Niue

690-705 [Repealed]

706 Limitation of actions

Miscellaneous Rules of Law

707 Legal status of married women

708 Legitimacy

709 Joint liability

710 Contracts of guarantee

711-713 [Repealed]

714 Liability of owners of dogs

715 Distress for rent abolished

716 Libel and slander

717-719 [Repealed]

720 Statutory declarations

721 [Repealed]

722 Taxes on Niuean land

723 [Repealed]

724 Warrants of arrest

725 Trespass ab initio

726 [Repealed]

727 [Repealed]

727A Births and deaths

728-735 [Repealed]

736 Contributory negligence

737 Protection of intellectual property

738 Aerodromes

SCHEDULES


1146 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

To consolidate and amend certain enactments relating to the Government and laws of Niue

THE EXECUTIVE GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

4–14D [Repealed by 1974/64]

15 [Repealed by 1974/64]

16–19 [Repealed by 2004/270]

20 [Repealed by 1974/64]

21 Persons authorised to practise medicine or surgery

(1) No person shall practise medicine or surgery in Niue, for fee, salary, or
other remuneration or reward of any nature whatsoever, unless –
(a) He is registered as a medical practitioner in New Zealand;
(b) He holds a certificate issued under the hand of the Secretary to the
Medical Council of New Zealand that, in the opinion of that Council,
he has attained a standard of practice in medicine and surgery
equivalent to that required for registration as a medical practitioner
in New Zealand;
(c) He –
(i) is a graduate of the Fiji School of Medicine; or
(ii) holds a certificate issued under the hand of the Director of
Health that, in the opinion of the Director, he is a graduate of a
school of medicine equivalent in standard to the Fiji School of
Medicine, and has attained a competent standard of practice
in medicine and surgery.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) (c) –
(a) If no conditions are prescribed by Act and the position of Director
of Health is vacant and no acting Director of Health has been
appointed; or
(b) If no conditions are so prescribed and the Director of Health is absent
from Niue or is otherwise incapable of performing his duties,
exercising his powers, and carrying out his functions,
any such graduate employee may practise medicine or surgery in Niue, subject to
the general control of Cabinet and not otherwise.

Niue Act 1966 1147

22 Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence who, not being a medical officer –
(a) Directly or by implication represents or holds himself out to be a
medical officer; or
(b) Engages, for or without any fee, salary, or other remuneration or
reward, in the practice of medicine or surgery, or any branch of
medicine or surgery, under the style or title of physician, surgeon,
doctor, licentiate in medicine or surgery, bachelor of medicine, or
medical practitioner, or under any name, title, addition, or
description implying that he holds any degree or diploma in
medicine or surgery or in any branch of medicine or surgery, or is
otherwise specially qualified to practise medicine or surgery or any
branch of medicine or surgery.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this section is liable –
(a) On a first conviction, to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit, and,
where the offence is a continuing one, to a further fine not exceeding
1 penalty unit for each day on which the offence has continued;
(b) On a second or subsequent conviction, to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 2 months or to the penalties specified in paragraph
(a).

23 Director of Health

(1) There shall be appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission a
Director of Health of Niue.
(2) No person shall be qualified to be appointed or to hold office as Director
of Health of Niue, unless –
(a) He is qualified to practise medicine and surgery under section 21
(1)(a) or (b);
(b) Being a graduate of the Fiji School of Medicine he holds such other
qualification, or has had such work experience in medicine, or has
a combination of such other qualification and such world experience
in medicine, as the Commission thinks fit.
(3) [Spent]
(4) Whenever the position of Director of Health is vacant, or the Director
of Health is absent from Niue or is in the opinion of the Niue Public Service
Commission unable, by reason of physical or mental disability, to perform the
functions of his office, the Niue Public Service Commission, may, by an instrument
in writing appoint any medical officer to be the acting Director of Health:
Provided that no medical officer, other than a person qualified to be
appointed as Director of Health, shall be appointed acting Director of Health unless,
in the opinion of the Niue Public Service Commission there is in Niue no medical
officer who is qualified and willing to occupy the position of Director of Health,
and is capable of performing the duties, exercising the powers, and carrying out
the functions of the Director of Health.
(5) Any appointment made under subsection (4) of an acting Director of
Health may, by an instrument in writing at any time be revoked by the Niue Public
Service Commission.
(6) An acting Director of Health shall, during the subsistence of his
appointment, perform all the duties, exercise all the powers, and carry out all the
functions of the Director of Health, whether conferred by this Act or any other
enactment.
1148 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(7) The appointment of an acting Director of Health shall not, on the grounds that the occasion for the appointment has not arisen or has ceased, be impugned or called into question in any proceedings in any court or otherwise howsoever.
(8) The Director of Health shall be responsible, in Niue, for the administration of all laws relating to public health, mental health, hospitals, medical and surgical services, and the quarantine of persons.

23A Medical services

(1) Without restricting section 23 (8) it shall be the duty of the Director of
Health to provide for all persons in Niue such medical and surgical services as
may be reasonably required and reasonably practicable.
(2) Medical and surgical treatment, aid, and attendance provided by any
medical officer employed in the Niue Public Service may, in the case of Niueans,
be gratuitous; and shall, in the case of all other persons, be subject to payment of
any reasonable and proper fees which may either generally or in any particular
instance, be fixed or prescribed by Cabinet and all fees for such treatment, aid,
and attendance shall be paid into and shall form part of the public revenues of
Niue.
(3) No liability shall be incurred by the Crown in respect of any failure or neglect to provide any services referred to in subsection (1) or any treatment, aid, or attendance referred to in subsection (2) or in respect of any negligence, wrongful act, or wrongful omission on the part of any medical officer employed in the Niue Public Service.

24–25 [Repealed by 2004/270]

26 Establishment of prisons

The Cabinet may, by warrant under its hand and the Seal of Niue, appoint
as prisons such buildings or places in Niue as it thinks suitable for that purpose.

27 Detention of persons in custody

(1) Any person in lawful custody in Niue may be detained in any such
prison, and may be removed by order of a Judge of the Court to any other prison
in Niue.
(2) Any person in lawful custody in Niue may, if it is inconvenient or
impracticable immediately to take him to any prison for confinement, be
temporarily detained in any other suitable place of security.

28 Labour instead of imprisonment

(1) Any person sentenced to imprisonment or committed to prison in Niue
may, by order of a Judge of the High Court made either at the time of sentence or
committal or at any time thereafter, be discharged from custody on condition that
he labours on public works in Niue for the term or the residue of the term for
which he has been so sentenced or committed.
(2) Every prisoner so discharged shall perform the labour so appointed
for him under the control and subject to the direction of some officer nominated
for that purpose by the Chief of Police.

Niue Act 1966 1149

(3) If any prisoner so discharged makes default in the due performance of the labour so appointed for him, or is guilty of any insubordination or other misconduct, whether in respect of that labour or otherwise, he may be arrested without warrant by any officer of police or of prisons; and a Judge of the High Court may (without the necessity of any judicial inquiry) revoke the discharge of that prisoner and commit him to prison for a period equal to that for which he would have been imprisoned subsequent to the order of discharge had no such order been made, with such deduction (if any) as the Judge thinks fit, having regard to the seriousness of the default, insubordination, or misconduct, and to any labour duly performed by the prisoner under the conditions of his discharge. (4) Where under subsection (3) a prisoner is committed to prison for a
term expiring before the date on which, if he had not been discharged under this
section, the original period of imprisonment would have expired, then, on the
expiration of the term for which he is committed under that subsection, the order
of discharge made under subsection (1) and subsections (2) and (3) shall again
apply to him for the residue of the term for which he was originally sentenced or
committed.

29 [Repealed by 2004/270]

29A Prisons and criminal justice

(1) Cabinet may by regulations provide for –
(a) The administration of sentences imposed by the Court (whether
involving imprisonment or not);
(b) The management and supervision of offenders placed in the custody
or under the control of the Controller of Prisons, a Superintendent,
or Parole and Probation Officers;
(c) The administration of prisons and other detention centres;
(d) The administration of the parole system and probation service;
(e) All other matters necessary or expedient for ensuring that full effect
is given to decisions of the courts in criminal matters.
(2) Regulations made under subsection (1) may provide for prison
discipline and for control of breach of discipline by the officer in charge of the
prison.
(3) Punishments imposed under regulations made under this section shall
not exceed –
(a) Confinement in a separate cell for a period of 2 weeks;
(b) The forfeiture of privileges for 3 months; or
(c) A combination of the punishments specified in paragraphs (a) to
(b).

30 [Repealed by 1974/64]

PART 2
THE LEGISLATIVE GOVERNMENT OF NIUE

31–44 [Repealed by 1974/64]

45–46 [Repealed by 1971/61]

47 [Repealed by 1974/64]

48 [Repealed by 2004/269]

1150 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

49 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make such regulations as it thinks fit for the purposes of
this Act and in such regulations provide for the taking of fees, the imposing of
charges, and the imposition of penalties for contravention of regulations.
(2) Such regulations may amend or repeal the Sea Carriage of Goods Act
1940 as promulgated for Niue by the Cook Islands Sea Carriage of Goods Order
1946, and may amend or repeal the Marine Pollution Act 1974 and rules made
under it following the original extension to Niue of the Oil in Navigable Waters
Act 1965 under the Niue (New Zealand) Laws Regulations 1972.

50–52 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 3
THE HIGH COURT OF NIUE

Constitution of the High Court

53–59 [Repealed by 1974/64]

60 Commissioners of High Court

A Commissioner of the High Court shall possess and may exercise the
powers and functions of a Judge of that Court (whether judicial or administrative,
but excluding those vested exclusively in the Chief Justice).

61 [Repealed by 1974/64]

62 Registrar and Deputy Registrar of the High Court

(1) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(2) The Registrar of the Court shall keep the records of the High Court,
and shall perform all such administrative duties in respect of that Court as the
Chief Justice may direct.
(3) The Deputy Registrar of the Court shall, subject to the control of the
Registrar, possess, exercise, and perform the same powers, functions, and duties,
as the Registrar; and every reference in this Act to a Registrar of the High Court
shall, so far as applicable, extend and apply to the Deputy Registrar accordingly.

63 [Repealed by 2004/270]

64 Seal of the High Court

The High Court shall have in the custody of each Judge and Commissioner
and the Registrar a seal of the Court, in such form or forms as Cabinet approves,
for the sealing of all orders, warrants, records and other instruments requiring to
be sealed.

65 Records of the High Court

The Registrar of the High Court shall keep proper books in which shall be
entered minutes of all proceedings in the Court, whether in its civil or criminal
jurisdiction.

Jurisdiction of the High Court

66 [Repealed by 1974/64]

67 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Niue Act 1966 1151

68 Habeas corpus

The High Court may, on the application of any person, make an order for
the release of any person from unlawful imprisonment or detention, or for the
production before the Court of any person alleged to be unlawfully imprisoned
or detained, and every person who disobeys any such order shall be guilty of
contempt of the High Court.

69 Custody of minors

(1) The High Court may, on the application of any person, make such order
as it thinks fit with respect to the custody of any minor (being unmarried) by any
parent or guardian of that minor.
(2) Where the Court is satisfied that the minor has no parent or guardian
fit to have such custody, the Court may make such order as it thinks fit for the
custody of the minor by any other person.
(3) The jurisdiction conferred by this section shall in all cases be exercised
in such manner as the Court deems most conducive to the welfare of the minor.

70 Rules of Court

Procedure of the High Court

(1) The Cabinet may, after consultation with the Chief Justice, make rules of court determining –
(a) The practice and procedure of the High Court (whether in its civil or criminal jurisdiction, including its jurisdiction in relation to land); and
(b) The practice and procedure of the Court of Appeal.
(2) Rules of court made under subsection (1) may require an appellant to
give security for the costs of an appeal, and may provide for the dismissal of an
appeal by the High Court or by a Judge of the Court by reason of the failure of the
appellant to conform to any such requirement or to prosecute the appellant’s appeal
under those rules of court; and no appeal to the Court of Appeal lies from any
such dismissal of an appeal.

71 Procedure so far as not governed by rules of Court

Subject to any enactment, the practice and procedure of the High Court in
the exercise of its civil and criminal jurisdiction shall be such as the Court thinks
in each case to be most consistent with natural justice and convenience.

72 Forms

Subject to any enactment, all statements of claim, informations, summonses,
warrants, convictions, orders, recognisances, and other documents required or
authorised in the course of the civil or criminal jurisdiction of the High Court may
be in such form as the Court or the Judge, Registrar, or other officer by whom they
are issued, made, or received thinks sufficient.

73 Summons to witnesses

A Judge or Registrar of the High Court may in any proceedings before the
Court, whether civil or criminal, issue a summons to any person requiring him to
appear before the Court at the time and place mentioned in the summons, there to
give evidence in those proceedings or to produce any document to the Court in
those proceedings.
1152 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

74 Default of witness

Every person shall be guilty of contempt of the High Court who –
(a) Having been served with any such summons, neglects or fails
without sufficient cause shown by him to appear or to produce any
document which he is so required to produce; or
(b) Whether summoned to attend or not, is present in Court and, being
required to give evidence or to produce any document then in his
possession, refuses, without sufficient cause shown by him, to be
sworn or to give evidence or to produce that document; or
(c) Having been sworn to give evidence in any proceedings, neglects
or fails without sufficient cause shown by him to appear at such
time as the Court directs for the purpose of giving further evidence
in the proceedings.

75 Commissioners to take evidence

The High Court may, in any civil or criminal proceedings where it appears
necessary for the purposes of justice, make an order for the examination on oath
before any officer of the Court or any other person or persons, and at any place
either in or out of Niue, of any witness or person and may order any deposition so
taken to be filed in the Court, and may empower any party to the proceedings to
give the deposition in evidence.

76 Evidence by affidavit sworn out of Niue

In any proceedings in the Court, an affidavit made out of Niue may, with
the leave of the Court, be received in evidence if made before a solicitor of the
High Court of New Zealand, or in any other manner by which the affidavit would
be admissible in civil proceedings in New Zealand.

77 Witnesses may be ordered out of Court

The High Court may at any time during any proceedings, whether civil or
criminal, order all witnesses other than the witness under examination to go and
remain outside the Court until required to give evidence; and any witness who
disobeys any such order shall be guilty of contempt of the High Court.

78 Affidavits in Niue

(1) Affidavits in the High Court may be sworn in Niue before –
(a) A Commissioner of the High Court;
(b) A Solicitor of the High Court of New Zealand;
(c) The Registrar of the High Court;
(d) A Postmaster;
(e) The Financial Secretary;
(f) [Repealed by 1974/64]
(g) A medical officer.
(2) The making of such affidavits shall be governed by the same rules as
are in force for the time being with respect to affidavits in the High Court of Niue.

79 Evidence by affidavit

In any civil proceedings in the High Court evidence may be taken either
orally or by affidavit, but in actions and other proceedings inter partes affidavits
shall not be admissible without the leave of the Court.

Niue Act 1966 1153

80 Right of audience in the High Court

In any proceedings in the High Court, whether civil or criminal, any party
may be represented either by a barrister or solicitor of the High Court of New
Zealand, or, with the leave of the Court, by any other agent, but any such leave
may be at any time withdrawn.

81 Costs

In any proceedings in the High Court, the Court shall have the power to
make such order for the payment of the costs of the proceedings by or to any
party.

82 Security for costs

(1) In any civil proceedings and at any stage of them, the High Court may
require a plaintiff or applicant resident out of the jurisdiction of the High Court to
deposit any sum of money as security for costs, and may stay the proceedings
pending the making of that deposit.
(2) When any sum has been so deposited as security for costs, it shall be
disposed of in such manner as the Court directs.

83 Court fees

The scale of costs and Court fees to be paid in all civil or criminal proceedings
in the High Court shall be as prescribed.

84 Minutes of judgments

(1) Every judgment of the High Court shall be deemed to be complete
when a minute of it has been made in the record books of the Court and signed by
a Judge of the Court.
(2) When necessary, the judgment may at any time after that be drawn up
under the seal of the Court.

85 Amendments

A Judge of the High Court may amend any minute or judgment of the
Court or other record of the Court, in order to give effect to the true intent of the
Court in respect of it or truly to record the course of any proceedings.

86 Rehearing of civil proceedings

(1) On application made at any time within 14 days after the date of any
judgment given by the High Court in its civil jurisdiction, the Court may rehear
the matter, and may on the rehearing either affirm, reverse, or vary the judgment.
(2) The Court may rehear the matter on an application made more than 14
days after the date of the judgment, if the Court is satisfied that the application
could not reasonably be made sooner.

87 Rehearing of criminal proceedings

(1) Where on the hearing of any information the accused has been
convicted, the High Court may grant a rehearing of the information, either as to
the whole matter or only as to the sentence, upon such terms as the Court thinks
fit.
(2) When a rehearing has been granted, the conviction or, as the case may be, the sentence only shall immediately cease to have effect.
1154 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) If a rehearing is granted in any case where the accused was on conviction sentenced to a term of imprisonment that has not expired, but the hearing is not proceeded with immediately, the Court may remand the accused in custody or admit the accused to bail, with or without sureties until the date appointed for the rehearing.
(4) On any rehearing the Court shall have the same powers and shall follow
the same procedure as if it were the first hearing.
(5) If the defendant does not appear on the date set down for the
rehearing of any information, the Court may, without rehearing the case direct
that the original conviction or sentence, as the case may be, shall be restored.

Executions of Judgments

88 Writs of sale and possession

(1) Where by any judgment of the High Court in its civil jurisdiction any
person is ordered to pay any sum of money, the party to whom the money is
payable may cause a writ of sale to be issued.
(2) Where by any judgment of the High Court any person is ordered to
deliver possession of land or chattels, the party to whom the land or chattels are
ordered to be delivered may cause a writ of possession to be issued.

89 Effect of writ of possession

A writ of possession shall authorise the officer to whom it is addressed to
deliver to any party named in the writ, possession of any land or of any chattels
specified in the writ, and for that purpose to eject any other person from the land,
or to seize and take possession of any such chattels.

90 Effect of writ of sale

(1) A writ of sale shall authorise the officer to whom it is directed to seize
all the chattels (including money, cheques, bills of exchange, and other securities
for money) of the person against whom it is issued, except wearing apparel,
bedding, tools and implements of trade, not exceeding in the aggregate one
hundred dollars in value.
(2) All chattels so seized may, unless the judgment is sooner satisfied,
together with the costs of the execution, be sold or otherwise converted into money
by the Registrar, and the proceeds of the sale or conversion, after payment from
them of the costs of the execution, shall be applied in satisfaction of the judgment.

91 Issue of writs of sale or possession

Every writ of sale or writ of possession shall be issued by the Registrar
under the seal of the High Court, and shall be addressed to an officer of the Court
or to a constable.

92 Charging orders

(1) Any judgment of the High Court in its civil jurisdiction for the payment
of any sum of money may be enforced by a charging order made by the Court
against any real or personal property of the person by whom the money is payable
(including debts and other money due or accruing due to that person, but not
including the interest of a Niuean in any Niuean land).
(2) Any such charging order shall be made and shall have effect in manner
provided by rules of Court.

Niue Act 1966 1155

93 Stay of execution

The High Court may in any civil proceedings stay the execution of any
judgment for such term as the Court thinks fit.

94 Judgment summons

(1) When judgment for the payment of any debt, damages, or other sum
of money has been given by the High Court in its civil jurisdiction, the judgment
creditor may at any time after judgment file in Court an application for an order
under this section.
(2) A Judge or the Registrar of the Court may thereupon issue a summons
(a judgment summons) to the judgment debtor to show cause why an order should
not be made against him for the payment of the amount of the judgment.
(3) On the hearing of the application, the Court may make an order that
the judgment debtor pay to the judgment creditor the amount of the judgment
debt forthwith, or at such time or by such instalments as the Court thinks fit.
(4) Except where the judgment debtor fails to appear in Court in pursuance
of the judgment summons, no such order shall be made, unless the Court is satisfied
either –
(a) That the judgment debtor is of sufficient ability to pay the judgment debt under the terms of the order; or
(b) That the liability in respect of which judgment was given against
him was incurred by fraud; or
(c) That before or after the date of the judgment the judgment debtor
has made away with any property for the purpose of evading
payment of the liability.
(5) If any judgment debtor disobeys any order made against him under
this section, he shall be guilty of contempt of the High Court.
(6) Nothing in this section shall exclude any other lawful method of
executing any such judgment.

95 Enforcement of foreign judgments

(1) In this section –
“final decision” means a judgment from which there is no appeal in the
courts of the country where the judgment was originally made or, when
the judgment is executory, because the time for appealing the judgment
has expired;
“judgment” means a final decision of a court other than a court of Niue, in
criminal or civil proceedings, for the payment of a sum of money as
compensation or damages, and includes arbitral awards and
maintenance orders but excludes sums payable in respect of a fine or
other penalty;
“judgment creditor” means the person in whose favour a judgment was
given and any person who has rights under a judgment.
(2) A judgment may be enforceable in Niue if –
(i) the foreign court had jurisdiction to decide the matter; and
(ii) it is for a definite sum of money; and
(iii) enforcement would not be contrary to the public policy of Niue;
and
(iv) a certified copy of the judgment has been filed for registration
in the High Court within 2 years from the date on which it was
made or became executory.
1156 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) After receiving an application to register a judgment, the High Court shall issue a summons –
(i) calling upon the person against whom the judgment was obtained to show within 30 days why execution should not issue on the judgment; and
(ii) giving notice that in default of appearance an order for
execution of the judgment will be issued.
(4) In default of appearance within 30 days, or if the person served with
such summons fails to show sufficient cause against it, the judgment will be
registered.
(5) No order of registration shall be issued where a judgment creditor has
shown that the judgment –
(i) has been wholly satisfied; or
(ii) could not be enforced in the courts of the country where the
judgment was originally made.
(6) Where a judgment has been partially satisfied, it shall be registered
only in respect of a sum remaining unpaid under it.
(7) After registration the judgment may be enforced in the same manner
as if it were a judgment originally given in the High Court on the date of
registration.
(8) No foreign judgment shall be enforced in Niue other than by way of
registration under this section.
(9) A judgment shall be recognised by a court of Niue as conclusive between
the parties in a case founded on the same cause of action and as a defence or
counter-claim if it satisfies subsection (2) (i) (ii) and (iii).

Absconding Debtors

96 Order of arrest of absconding debtor

Where in any action in the High Court for the recovery of any debt, damages,
or other sum of money the plaintiff proves to the satisfaction of the Court, at any
time before final judgment, that he has a good cause of action against the defendant
to the amount of 0.5 penalty units or upwards, and that there is probable cause for
believing that the defendant is about to leave Niue unless he is apprehended, and
that his absence from Niue will materially prejudice the plaintiff in the prosecution
of his action, the Court may order the defendant to be arrested and imprisoned
for a period not exceeding 3 months unless and until he sooner give security to
the satisfaction of the Court that he will not leave Niue without the leave of the
Court.

96A Commissioner and Justices’ authority

Any power conferred by this Act on the Court to make an order under
section 96 may be exercised by a Commissioner of the High Court or any 2 Justices
of the Peace if when the power is exercised there is not present in Niue a Judge
who is able to exercise it.

97 Security to be given

The security to be so given shall, as the Court directs, be either the payment
into Court of a sum not exceeding the amount claimed in the action or a bond
executed by the defendant with one or 2 sureties in favour of Her Majesty in the
like amount.

Niue Act 1966 1157

98 Enforcement of security

If after such security has been given the defendant leaves Niue without the
leave of the Court, all money so paid into Court or recovered in pursuance of the
bond shall become available as the Court directs for the satisfaction of any sum
recovered in the action.

99 Arrest in actions for penalties

Where the action is for a penalty at the suit of the Crown, it shall not be
necessary to prove that the absence of the defendant as aforesaid will materially
prejudice the Crown in the prosecution of the action, and the security to be given
shall be security that any sum recovered against the defendant in the action will
be paid or that the defendant will be rendered to prison.

100 Enforcement of security in actions for penalties

If, after such security has been given, any sum recovered in the action
remains unpaid and the defendant is not rendered to prison, all money so paid
into Court or recovered in pursuance of the bond shall become available as the
Court directs for the satisfaction of the sum recovered in the action.

Contempt of the High Court

101 Contempt of Court defined

Every person is guilty of contempt of the High Court who –
(a) Disobeys any judgment or order of that Court, or of any Judge,
otherwise than by making default in the payment of a sum of money
(other than a penalty) or compensation payable under the judgment
or order; or
(b) Uses any abusive, insulting, offensive, or threatening words or
behaviour in the presence or hearing of the Court; or
(c) Assaults, resists, or obstructs, or incites any other person to assault,
resist, or obstruct, any constable or officer of the Court in serving
any process of the Court, or executing any warrant of the Court or
of a Judge or executing any judgment or order of the Court or of a
Judge; or
(d) By the words or behaviour obstructs in any manner the proper and
orderly administration of justice in the Court; or
(e) Does any other thing which elsewhere in this Act or in any other
Act is declared to be a contempt of the High Court; or
(f) Aids, abets, counsels, procures, or incites any other person to commit
contempt of the High Court.

102 Penalty for contempt

Every person who commits contempt of the High Court is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or a fine not exceeding 1 penalty
unit.

103 Jurisdiction in contempt

The offence of contempt of the High Court shall be punishable by the High
Court either –
(a) In the ordinary course of the criminal jurisdiction of that Court; or
(b) Under section 104.
1158 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

104 Contempt in the face of the Court

(1) If the contempt is committed in the presence or hearing of the Court,
any Judge then and there sitting in Court may, without order or warrant, direct
any constable, officer of the Court, or other person to arrest the person so guilty of
contempt and to bring him before the Court.
(2) The Court may thereupon, after giving the person so arrested a
reasonable opportunity of being heard in his defence, either commit him to prison
for a term not exceeding 6 months or order him to pay a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit.

105 Discharge of persons in contempt

A person imprisoned for contempt, or for default in payment of a fine
imposed upon him for contempt, may be at any time discharged, and any fine so
imposed may be at any time remitted in whole or in part by order of the Court.

106 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 4
THE HIGH COURT

107 Declarations

A person may apply to the High Court for a declaration where the
applicant –
(i) has done or desires to do an act the validity, legality, or effect of which depends on the construction or validity of an enactment or of any document; or
(ii) claims to have acquired any rights under any such enactment or document, or in any other manner to be interested in its construction or validity; or
(iii) wishes to have a formal statement as to the existence or non­
existence of a marriage or the validity of a dissolution of
marriage.

108 [Repealed by 2004/270]

109 Cases stated

(1) The High Court may in any proceedings before it, either on the
application of a party or of its own motion, state a case on a question of law for
determination by the Court of Appeal.
(2) In the order of the Court of Appeal which determines the case stated,
the Court of Appeal may fix the costs of the argument and determination of the
case stated.

110 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Appeals from the High Court

111-112 [Repealed by 1974/64]

113 Transmission of record

Where an appeal is made to the Court of Appeal against a final judgment
of the High Court, a copy of the record of the proceedings in which the judgment
appealed against was given (including the reasons for the judgment, and, where
necessary, a statement of the facts or of the evidence) shall be prepared by the
appellant and transmitted to the Registrar of the Court of Appeal.

Niue Act 1966 1159

114 Dismissal of appeal for non-prosecution

If the appellant does not prosecute his appeal with due diligence, the
respondent may apply to the High Court for an order dismissing the appeal for
non-prosecution; and, if such an order is made, the costs of the appeal and the
security entered into by the appellant shall be dealt with in such manner as that
Court may direct.

115 Procedure on appeal

The procedure on the hearing of any such appeal and in all matters
incidental to any such appeal, whether in the High Court or in the Court of Appeal
shall, subject to this Act, be determined by the rules of the High Court or the
Court of Appeal and in default of such rules, or so far as they do not extend, shall
be determined in such manner as the Court thinks fit.

116 [Repealed by 1974/64]

117 Powers of Court of Appeal

(1) On any appeal from the High Court, the Court of Appeal may affirm,
reverse, or vary the judgment appealed from, or may order a new trial, or may
make any such order with respect to the appeal as the Court of Appeal thinks fit,
and may award such costs as it thinks fit to or against any party to the appeal.
(2) Without limiting the general powers conferred by subsection (1), the
Court of Appeal on any appeal against sentence, if it thinks that a different sentence
should have been passed, shall quash the sentence passed and pass such other
sentence warranted by law (whether more or less severe) in substitution therefore
as the Court thinks ought to have been passed, and in any other case shall dismiss
the appeal.

118 Evidence on appeal

Every such appeal shall, so far as it relates to any question of fact, be
determined by the Court of Appeal by reference to the evidence heard at the trial
as certified to the Court of Appeal under the seal of the High Court, and no further
evidence shall, without the leave of the Court of Appeal be heard or admitted.

119 Stay of execution

An appeal to the Court of Appeal shall not operate as a stay of execution,
unless the High Court or the Court of Appeal otherwise orders.

120 Release of appellant from custody

(1) When an appeal is made to the Court of Appeal from any conviction in
the High Court, the High Court may release the appellant from custody on bail
pending the determination of the appeal.
(2) Any person so released on bail may be at any time, and for any reason
which the High Court thinks sufficient, arrested by warrant and committed to
prison, there to undergo his sentence.
(3) Any period during which an appellant has been so at large on bail
shall not be computed as part of the term of imprisonment to which he has been
sentenced.
1160 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

121 Appeal not to be allowed for irregularities

No judgment of the High Court shall, on appeal to the Court of Appeal, be
set aside on the ground of any error or irregularity in the proceedings of the High
Court, or on the ground of any defect of form or substance in the judgment, unless
the Court of Appeal is of opinion that the proceedings of the High Court were not
in conformity with natural justice or that a substantial miscarriage of justice has
taken place.

122 Right of audience on appeal

On every case stated for the Court of Appeal and in every appeal to that
Court, the parties may either appear in person or be represented by a person who
has right of audience in the High Court, or may submit their arguments to the
Court of Appeal in writing.

123 Transmission of order of Court of Appeal

The determination of the Court of Appeal on any appeal from the High
Court shall be entered in the High Court in conformity with that determination,
or such other proceedings by way of a new trial or otherwise shall be taken in the
High Court as are required by the determination.

124 [Repealed by 1974/64]

125 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Enforcement in Niue of Judgments of New Zealand Courts

126 Judgments of High Court or a District Court in New Zealand may be

enforced by the High Court

(1) Any person in whose favour any judgment whereby any sum of money
is made payable has been obtained in the High Court of New Zealand or in a
District Court in New Zealand in civil proceedings may cause a memorial of it,
authenticated by the seal of the High Court of New Zealand or of the District
Court, as the case may be, to be filed in the High Court of Niue.
(2) Judicial notice may be taken by the High Court of Niue of the seal of
the New Zealand Court so affixed to any such memorial.
(3) Every such memorial shall set forth the names and additions of the
parties to the proceedings in which the judgment was given, the form or nature of
the proceedings, the date on which the judgment was given, and the amount
payable under it.
(4) Every such memorial being so filed shall thenceforth be a record of the
judgment, and execution may issue on it with the leave of the High Court in the
same manner as if the like judgment had been given by the High Court, subject to
such terms and conditions as the High Court may impose.
(5) Leave to issue such execution may be given by the High Court on the
application of the party by whom the memorial was filed, and either ex parte or on
notice to the party against whom execution is to be issued, as the High Court
thinks fit.

Niue Act 1966 1161

127 Enforcement of judgments of the High Court of New Zealand by High

Court by way of proceedings for contempt

(1) When by any judgment of the High Court of New Zealand any person
has been ordered to do or abstain from doing any act in Niue other than the
payment of money, the High Court of New Zealand may then or at any time
thereafter direct a memorial of the judgment under the seal of the court to be filed
in the High Court of Niue.
(2) On the filing of such a memorial, any disobedience to the judgment,
whether before or after the filing of the memorial, shall be deemed to be a contempt
of the High Court of Niue.

128 [Repealed by 2004/270]

129 Seditious offences

PART 5
CRIMINAL OFFENCES
(1) A seditious intention is an intention to excite disaffection against Her Majesty, or against the Parliament or Government of New Zealand, or against the Government of Niue, or to excite such hostility or ill will between different classes of the inhabitants of Niue as may be injurious to the public welfare, or to incite, encourage, or procure lawlessness, violence, or disorder in Niue, or to procure otherwise than by lawful means the alteration of any matter affecting the laws, government, or constitution of Niue.
(2) No one shall be deemed to have a seditious intention only because he
intends in good faith –
(a) To show that Her Majesty has been misled or mistaken in her
measures; or
(b) To point out errors or defects in the Parliament or Government of
New Zealand or in the Government of Niue; or to incite the
inhabitants of Niue to attempt to procure by lawful means the
alteration of any matter affecting the laws, government, or
constitution of Niue; or
(c) To point out, with a view to their removal, matters producing or
having a tendency to produce hostility or ill will between different
classes of the inhabitants of Niue.
(3) Seditious words are words expressive of a seditious intention.
(4) A seditious libel is a libel expressive of a seditious intention.
(5) A seditious conspiracy is an agreement between 2 or more persons to
carry into execution a seditious intention.

130 Punishment of seditious offences

Every person is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years
who speaks any seditious words, or publishes a seditious libel, or is a party to a
seditious conspiracy.

131 Homicide

Homicide is the killing of a human being by another, directly or indirectly,
by any means whatsoever.
1162 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

132 Killing of a child

(1) A child becomes a human being within the meaning of this Act when it
has completely proceeded in a living state from the body of its mother, whether it
has breathed or not, whether it has an independent circulation or not, and whether
the navel string is severed or not.
(2) The killing of such a child is homicide if it dies in consequence of injuries
received before, during, or after birth.

133 Culpable homicide

(1) Homicide may be either culpable or not culpable.
(2) Homicide is culpable when it consists in the killing of any person –
(a) By an unlawful act; or
(b) By an omission without lawful excuse to perform or observe any
legal duty; or
(c) By both combined; or
(d) By causing that person by threats or fear of violence, or by deception,
to do an act which causes his death; or
(e) By wilfully frightening that person, if he is a child under the age of
16 years or is sick or infirm.
(3) Culpable homicide is either murder or manslaughter.
(4) Homicide that is not culpable is not an offence.

134 Murder

Culpable homicide is murder in each of the following cases:
(a) If the offender means to cause the death of the person killed;
(b) If the offender means to cause to the person killed any bodily injury
that is known to the offender to be likely to cause death, and is
reckless whether death ensues or not;
(c) If the offender means to cause death, or, being so reckless as
aforesaid, means to cause such bodily injury as aforesaid to one
person, and by accident or mistake kills another person, though he
does not mean to hurt the person killed;
(d) If the offender for any unlawful object does an act that he knows to
be likely to cause death, and thereby kills any person though he
may have desired that his object should be effected without hurting
anyone.

135 Further definition of murder

(1) Culpable homicide is also murder in each of the following cases,
whether the offender means or does not mean death to ensue, or knows or does
not know that death is likely to ensue –
(a) If he means to inflict grievous bodily injury for the purpose of
facilitating the commission of any of the offences mentioned in
subsection (2) or the flight of the offender upon the commission or
attempted commission of it, or for the purpose of resisting lawful
apprehension in respect of any other offence whatsoever, and death
ensues from such injury;
(b) If he administers any stupefying or overpowering thing for any of
the purposes aforesaid, and death ensues from the effects of it;
(c) If he by any means wilfully stops the breath of any person for any
of the purposes aforesaid, and death ensues from such stopping of
the breath.

Niue Act 1966 1163

(2) The offences referred to in subsection (1) are those within the meaning of the following provisions –
(a) Section 134 (murder);
(b) Section 158 (resisting a constable in the execution of his duty or any
person acting in aid of any constable;
(c) Section 159 (abduction of girl under 15);
(d) Section 162 (rape);
(e) Sections 184 to 186 (escape or rescue from prison or lawful custody);
(f) Section 195 (robbery);
(g) Section 204 (burglary);
(h) Section 212 (arson).

136 Provocation

(1) Culpable homicide that would otherwise be murder may be reduced
to manslaughter if the person who caused the death did so under provocation.
(2) Anything done or said may be provocation if –
(a) In the circumstances of the case it was sufficient to deprive a person
having the power of self-control of an ordinary person, but
otherwise having the characteristics of the person charged, of the
power of self-control; and
(b) It did in fact deprive the person charged of the power of self-control
and thereby induced him to commit the act of homicide.
(3) Whether there is any evidence of provocation is a question of law.
(4) Whether, if there is evidence of provocation, the provocation was
sufficient as aforesaid, and whether it did in fact deprive the person charged of
the power of self-control and thereby induced him to commit the act of homicide,
are questions of fact.
(5) No one shall be held to give provocation to another by lawfully
exercising any power conferred by law, or by doing anything which the person
charged incited him to do in order to provide the person charged with an excuse
for killing or doing bodily harm to any person.
(6) This section shall apply in any case where the provocation was given
by the person killed, and also in any case where the person charged, under
provocation given by one person, by accident or mistake killed another person.
(7) The fact that by virtue of this section one party to a homicide has not
been or is not liable to be convicted of murder shall not affect the question whether
the homicide amounted to murder in the case of any other party to it.

137 Illegal arrest may be evidence of provocation

An arrest shall not necessarily reduce the offence from murder to
manslaughter because the arrest was illegal, but if the illegality was known to the
person charged it may be evidence of provocation.

138 Punishment of murder

Every one who commits murder shall upon conviction of it be sentenced to
imprisonment for life.

139 Manslaughter

Culpable homicide not amounting to murder is manslaughter.
1164 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

140 Punishment of manslaughter

Every one who commits manslaughter is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 14 years.

141 Omissions dangerous to life

Every one who undertakes, whether by a legally binding contract or
otherwise, to do any act the omission of which is or may be dangerous to life is
under a legal duty to do that act, and is criminally responsible for the consequences
of omitting without lawful excuse to discharge that duty.

142 Duty to provide the necessaries of life

(1) Everyone who has charge of any other person unable, by reason of
detention, age, sickness, insanity, or any other cause, to withdraw himself from
such charge, and unable to provide himself with the necessaries of life, is (whether
such charge is undertaken by him under any contract or is imposed upon him by
law or by reason of his unlawful act or otherwise howsoever) under a legal duty
to supply that person with the necessaries of life, and is criminally responsible for
omitting, without lawful excuse to perform such duty if the death of that person
is caused, or if his life is endangered or his health permanently injured, by such
omission.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years
who, without lawful excuse, neglects the duty specified in this section so that the
life of the person under his charge is endangered or his health permanently injured
by such neglect.

143 Duty of parent or guardian to provide necessaries

(1) Every one who as a parent or person in place of a parent is under a
legal duty to provide necessaries for any child under the age of 16 years, being a
child in his actual custody, is criminally responsible for omitting without lawful
excuse to do so, whether the child is helpless or not, if the death of the child is
caused, or if his life is endangered or his health permanently injured, by such
omission.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years
who, without lawful excuse, neglects the duty specified in this section so that the
life of the child is endangered or his health permanently injured by such neglect.

144 Liability for dangerous things

Every one who has in his charge or under his control anything whatever,
whether animate or inanimate, or who erects, makes, or maintains anything
whatever, which in the absence of precaution or care may endanger human life is
under a legal duty to take reasonable precautions against and to use reasonable
care to avoid such danger, and is criminally responsible for the consequences of
omitting without lawful excuse to perform that duty.

145 Hastening death

Every one who hastens the death of any person from any disease or disorder
from which he is already suffering shall be deemed to have caused the death of
that person.

146 Indirect cause of death

Every one whose act or omission results in the death of any person shall be
deemed to have caused his death, although the immediate cause of death is the
act or omission of some other person or some other independent intervening event.

Niue Act 1966 1165

147 Attempted murder

Every one who attempts to commit murder is liable to imprisonment for a
term not exceeding 14 years.

148 Conspiracy and inciting to murder

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 10 years, who –
(a) Conspires with any person to murder any person; or
(b) Incites any person to commit murder.

149 Counselling suicide

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 14 years who
counsels or procures any person to commit suicide, if that person actually commits
suicide in consequence, or who aids or abets any person in the commission of
suicide.

150 Concealment of birth

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
disposes of the dead body of any child in any manner with intent to conceal the
fact that its mother was delivered of it, whether the child died before, or during,
or after birth.

151 Grievous bodily harm

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years who
wilfully and without lawful justification causes grievous bodily harm to any
person.

152 Actual bodily harm

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
wilfully and without lawful justification causes actual bodily harm to any person.

153 Omissions resulting in bodily harm

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
by any act or omission causes bodily harm to any person under such circumstances
that, if death had been caused, he would have been guilty of manslaughter.

154 Intentionally endangering persons on aerodromes

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 14 years who,
with intent to injure or endanger the safety of any person on any aerodrome or in
any aircraft –
(a) Places anything upon or across any aerodrome; or
(b) Does any act likely to interfere with, injure, endanger, or obstructs
any aircraft; or
(c) Shoots or throws anything at any person in any aircraft or at, into,
or upon, or causes anything to come in contact with, any aircraft;
or
(d) Does anything whatever to any part of any aerodrome or to any
machinery or signal belonging to or near to any aerodrome or to
any aircraft on, or about to land on or take off from, any aerodrome;
or
(e) Deals in any way with any signal or light on or near to any
aerodrome, or makes or shows any false signal or light or makes
any sign whatever on or near to any aerodrome; or
(f) Wilfully omits to do any act which it is his duty to do.
1166 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

155 Wantonly endangering persons on aerodromes

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
unlawfully and wilfully, in a manner likely to injure or endanger the safety of any
person on any aerodrome or in any aircraft, –
(a) By any act, omission, or neglect endangers or obstructs any aircraft;
or
(b) Does any act likely to interfere with or to cause injury to any aircraft;
or
(c) Shoots or throws anything at any person in any aircraft or at, into,
or upon, or causes anything to come in contact with, any aircraft;
or
(d) Does anything whatever to any part of any aerodrome or to any
machinery or signal belonging to or near to any aerodrome or to
any aircraft on, or about to land on or take off from, any aerodrome;
or
(e) Deals in any way with any signal or light on or near to any
aerodrome, or makes or shows any false signal or light or makes
any sign whatever on or near to any aerodrome; or
(f) By any culpable neglect of duty endangers the safety of any person
conveyed in any aircraft.

156 Indecent assault

Every one who indecently assaults any woman or girl is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years.

157 Assault

Every one who commits an assault on any person is liable to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding one year.

157A Cruelty to a child

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years who,
having the custody, control, or charge of a child under the age of 16 years, wilfully
illtreats or wilfully neglects the child, or wilfully permits the child to be illtreated
or neglected, in a manner likely to cause the child unnecessary suffering, actual
bodily harm, injury to health, or mental disorder, or to incur any other unnecessary
physical or mental disability.

158 Resisting constable in execution of his duty

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or
to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who resists or assaults or wilfully obstructs,
or incites or encourages any person to resist or assault or obstruct, any constable
in the execution of his duty, or any person acting in aid of any constable.

159 Abduction of girl under 15

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years
who, without the consent of the father or mother or other person having lawful
charge of an unmarried girl under the age of 15 years, or without other lawful
authority (the proof of which shall lie on him), takes that girl or causes her to be
taken out of the possession of her father or mother or such other person as aforesaid.
(2) It shall be no defence in a prosecution for an offence against this section
that the girl was taken with her own consent, or at her own suggestion, or that the
offender believed the girl to be of or over the age of 15 years.

Niue Act 1966 1167

(3) No proceedings for an offence against this section shall be taken in the event of the subsequent intermarriage of the offender and the girl in respect of whom the offence has been committed.

160 Abduction of children

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years
who, with intent to deprive any parent or guardian or other person having the
lawful charge of any child under the age of 14 years of the possession of that
child, unlawfully –
(a) Takes or entices away or detains the child; or
(b) Receives the child knowing it to have been so dealt with.
(2) Nothing in this section shall extend to any one who gets possession of
any child claiming in good faith a right to the possession of the child.

161 Sexual intercourse

For the purposes of this Part, sexual intercourse is complete upon
penetration; and there shall be no presumption of law that any person is by reason
of his age incapable of such intercourse.

162 Rape

(1) Rape is the act of a male person having sexual intercourse with a woman
or girl –
(a) Without her consent; or
(b) With consent extorted by threats or fear of bodily harm; or
(c) With consent obtained by personating her husband; or
(d) With consent obtained by false and fraudulent representations as
to the nature and quality of the act.
(2) Every one who commits rape is liable to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 14 years.
(3) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 10 years
who attempts to commit rape or who assaults any person with intent to commit
rape.
(4) Notwithstanding anything in subsection (1), no man shall be convicted of rape or attempting to commit rape or assaulting with intent to commit rape in respect of his wife, unless at the time of the intercourse or attempt a separation order granted in Niue or New Zealand was in force in respect of the marriage.

163 Sexual intercourse or indecency with girl under 12

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 10 years
who –
(a) Has sexual intercourse with any girl under the age of 12 years; or
(b) Attempts to have sexual intercourse with a girl under the age of 12
years; or
(c) Indecently assaults any girl under the age of 12 years; or
(d) Being a male, does any indecent act with or upon any girl under
the age of 12 years; or
(e) Being a male, induces or permits any girl under the age of 12 years
to do any indecent act with or upon him.
(2) It is no defence to a charge under this section that the girl consented, or
that the person charged believed that she was of or over the age of 12 years.
(3) The girl shall not be charged as a party to an offence committed upon
or with her against this section.
1168 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

164 Sexual intercourse or indecency with girl between 12 and 15

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years
who –
(a) Has or attempts to have sexual intercourse with any girl of or over the age of 12 years and under the age of 15 years, not being his wife; or
(b) Indecently assaults any such girl; or
(c) Being a male, does any indecent act with or upon any such girl;
(d) Being a male, induces or permits any such girl to do any indecent
act with or upon him.
(2) It is no defence to a charge under this section that the girl consented, or
that the person charged believed that the girl was of or over the age of 15 years. (3) The girl shall not be charged as a party to an offence committed upon
or with her against this section.

165 Sexual intercourse with woman or girl who is an idiot or imbecile or of unsound mind

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who has or attempts to have sexual intercourse with any woman or girl who is an idiot or an imbecile or of unsound mind, if he knows or has good reason to believe that she is an idiot or an imbecile or of unsound mind.

166 Procuring miscarriage of woman or girl

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who,
with intent to procure the miscarrriage of any woman or girl, unlawfully
administers to or causes to be taken by her any poison or any drug or other noxious
thing, or unlawfully uses any instrument or other means whatsoever with the like
intent.

167 Act of woman or girl procuring her own miscarriage

Every woman or girl is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year
who, whether with child or not, unlawfully administers to herself or permits to be
administered to her any poison or any drug or other noxious thing, or unlawfully
uses on herself or permits to be used on her any instrument or other means
whatsoever, with intent to procure miscarriage.

168 Supplying means of miscarriage

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
unlawfully supplies or procures any poison or any drug or other noxious thing,
or any instrument or thing whatsoever, knowing that it is intended to be unlawfully
used with intent to procure the miscarriage of any woman or girl.

169 Bigamy

(1) Every one who commits bigamy is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 5 years.
(2) Bigamy is –
(a) The act of a person who being married goes through a valid form
of marriage with any other person; or
(b) The act of a person who goes through a valid form of marriage
with any person whom he or she knows to be married.
(3) The fact that the parties would, if unmarried, have been incompetent
to contract marriage is not a defence upon a prosecution for bigamy.

Niue Act 1966 1169

(4) Every form of marriage shall for the purposes of this section be deemed valid, notwithstanding any act or default of the person charged with bigamy, if it is otherwise a valid form.

170 Buggery

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for 10 years who commits buggery
either with a human being or with any other living creature.
(2) This offence is complete upon penetration.

171 Attempted buggery and indecent assaults on males

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for 5 years who –
(a) Attempts to commit buggery; or
(b) Assaults any person with intent to commit buggery; or
(c) Being a male, indecently assaults any other male person.
(2) It is no defence to a charge of indecent assault on a male person of any
age that he consented to the act of indecency.

172 Incest

(1) Incest means sexual intercourse between –
(a) Parent and child; or
(b) Brother and sister, whether of the whole blood or of the half blood,
and whether the relationship is traced through lawful wedlock or
not; or
(c) Grandparent and grandchild, whether the relationship is traced
through lawful wedlock or not –
where the person charged knows of the relationship between the parties.
(2) Every one of or over the age of 15 years who commits incest is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years.

173 Indecent acts

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months
who wilfully does any indecent act in any public place or within the view of any
person being in any public place.
(2) It is a defence to a charge under subsection (1) if the person charged
proves that he had reasonable grounds for believing that he would not be observed.
(3) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months
who with intent to insult or offend any person does any indecent act in any place.

174 Indecent documents

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months
who, knowingly and without lawful justification or excuse –
(a) Sells, exposes for sale, or otherwise distributes to the public any
obscene or indecent book, picture, photograph, document, film,
video-tape, or other object tending to corrupt morals; or
(b) Publicly exhibits any obscene or indecent show tending to corrupt
morals.
1170 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

175 Brothels

(1) Every one who keeps a brothel is liable to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 6 months.
(2) A brothel is a house, room, or place of any kind whatever kept or used
for purposes of prostitution.
(3) Any one who acts as a person having the management, care, or control
of a brothel shall be deemed to be a keeper thereof, whether he is in fact a keeper
of it or not.
(4) The owner or occupier of any house, room, or place who knowingly
permits it to be used as a brothel shall be deemed to be a keeper of it, whether he
is in fact a keeper of it or not.

176 Gaming houses

(1) Every one who keeps a gaming house is liable to imprisonment for a
term not exceeding 6 months.
(2) A gaming house is a house, room, or place of any kind whatever kept
or used as a place of resort for gambling.
(3) “Gambling” means playing for money or other valuable thing at any
game of chance, or playing for excessive stakes or otherwise to the injury of public
morals at any game of mixed chance and skill; and includes any form of unlawful
gaming.
(4) Any one who acts as a person having the management, care, or control
of a gaming house shall be deemed to be a keeper of it, whether he is in fact a
keeper of it or not.
(6) The owner or occupier of any house, room, or place who knowingly
permits it to be used as a gaming house shall be deemed to be a keeper of it whether
he is in fact a keeper of it or not.

176A Powers to permit gambling

Notwithstanding section 176 Cabinet may make regulations to permit
certain gambling activities to be carried out in Niue, within certain guidelines
and to prescribe fees and offences in respect of such activities.

177 Riot

(1) Every one who takes part in a riot is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 2 years.
(2) A riot is an assembly of 3 or more persons who, with intent to carry out
any common purpose, disturb the peace tumultuously.

178 Forcible entry

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months
who, by force or threats of force, enters on land then in the actual and peaceable
possession of another for the purpose of taking possession of it, whether he who
so enters is entitled to the possession of it or not.

179 Affrays

(1) Every one who, without lawful justification or excuse, takes part in an
affray is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year.
(2) An affray is the act of fighting in a public highway or in any other
public place.

Niue Act 1966 1171

CRIMES AFFECTING THE ADMINISTRATION OF LAW AND JUSTICE

Bribery and Corruption

180 Interpretation

In this Part
“bribe” means any money, valuable consideration, office, or employment,
or any benefit, whether direct or indirect;
“judicial officer” means a Judge or Commissioner of any court, Coroner,
or Justice of the Peace, or any other person holding any judicial office,
or any person who is a member of any tribunal authorised by law to
take evidence on oath;
“law enforcement officer” means any constable, or any person employed
in the detection or prosecution or punishment of offenders;
“official” means any person in the service of Her Majesty in Niue (whether
that service is honorary or not, and whether it is within or outside of
Niue), or any member or employee of any local authority or public
body.

180A Judicial corruption

(1) Every judicial officer is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
14 years who corruptly accepts or obtains, or agrees or offers to accept or attempts
to obtain, any bribe for himself or any other person in respect of any act done or
omitted, or to be done or omitted, by him in his judicial capacity.
(2) Every judicial officer, and every Registrar or Deputy Registrar of any
court is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years who corruptly
accepts or obtains, or agrees or offers to accept or attempts to obtain any bribe for
himself or any other person in respect of any act done or omitted, or to be done or
omitted, by him in his official capacity, not being an act or omission to which
subsection (1) applies.

180B Bribery of judicial officer

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years
who corruptly gives or offers or agrees to give any bribe to any person with intent
to influence any judicial officer in respect of any act or omission by him in his
judicial capacity.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years
who corruptly gives or offers or agrees to give any bribe to any person with intent
to influence any judicial officer or any Registrar or Deputy Registrar of any court
in respect of any act or omission by him in his official capacity, not being an act or
omission to which subsection (1) applies.

180C Corruption and bribery of Minister

(1) Every Minister or member of the executive authority is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 14 years who corruptly accepts or obtains,
or agrees or offers to accept or attempts to obtain, any bribe for himself or any
other person in respect of any act done or omitted, or to be done or omitted, by
him in his capacity as a Minister or member of the executive authority.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years
who corruptly gives or offers or agrees to give any bribe to any person with intent
to influence any Minister or member of the executive authority in respect of any
act or omission by him in his capacity as a Minister or member of the executive
authority.
1172 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) No one shall be prosecuted for an offence against this section without the leave of a Judge or Commissioner of the Court.

180D Corruption and bribery of member of Assembly

(1) Every member of the Assembly is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 7 years who corruptly accepts or obtains, or agrees or offers to accept
or attempts to obtain, any bribe for himself or any other person in respect of any
act done or omitted, or to be done or omitted, by him in his capacity as a member
of the Assembly.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years
who corruptly gives or offers or agrees to give any bribe to any person with intent
to influence any member of the Assembly in respect of any act or omission by him
in his capacity as a member of the Assembly.
(3) No one shall be prosecuted for an offence against this section without
the leave of a Judge or Commissioner of the Court.

180E Corruption and bribery of law enforcement officer

(1) Every law enforcement officer is liable to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 7 years who corruptly accepts or obtains, or agrees or offers to accept
or attempts to obtain, any bribe for himself or any other person in respect of any
act done or omitted, or to be done or omitted, by him in his official capacity.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years
who corruptly gives or offers or agrees to give any bribe to any person with intent
to influence any law enforcement officer in respect of any act or omission by him
in his official capacity.

180F Corruption and bribery of official

(1) Every official is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years
who, whether within Niue or elsewhere, corruptly accepts or obtains, or agrees or
offers to accept or attempts to obtain, any bribe for himself or any other person in
respect of any act done or omitted, or to be done or omitted, by him in his official
capacity.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years
who corruptly gives or offers or agrees to give any bribe to any person with intent
to influence any official in respect of any act or omission by him in his official
capacity.

180G Corrupt use of official information

Every official is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years
who, whether within Niue or elsewhere, corruptly uses or discloses any
information, acquired by him in his official capacity, to obtain, directly or indirectly,
an advantage or pecuniary gain for himself or any other person.

180H Restrictions on prosecutions

No one shall be prosecuted for an offence against sections 180A, 180B, 180E,
180F and 180G without the leave of the Minister of Justice, who before giving
leave may make such inquiries as he thinks fit.

Niue Act 1966 1173

181 Perjury

(1) Perjury is an assertion as to a matter of fact, opinion, belief, or knowledge
made by a witness in a judicial proceeding as part of his evidence upon oath or
affirmation, whether his evidence is given in open court or by affidavit or otherwise,
that assertion being known to the witness to be false.
(2) Every proceeding is judicial within the meaning of this section which
is held before any court, or before any judicial officer or other person having power
to take evidence on oath or affirmation.
(3) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years
who commits perjury.

182 Fabricating evidence

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years who,
with intent to mislead any court or any judicial officer in the exercise of his functions
as such, fabricates evidence by any means other than perjury.

183 Conspiracy to pervert justice

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years who
conspires or attempts to obstruct, prevent, pervert, or defeat the course of justice
in any cause or matter, civil or criminal.

184 Breaking prison

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years who
by force breaks any prison with intent to set at liberty himself or any other person
confined there.

185 Escape

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who,
being in lawful custody, whether in a prison or elsewhere, escapes.

186 Rescue

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
rescues any person from lawful custody, whether in a prison or elsewhere, or who
assists any person to escape from such custody.

187 Criminal libel or slander

(1) A criminal libel is matter published, without lawful justification or
excuse, either designed to insult any person or likely to injure his reputation by
exposing him to hatred, contempt, or ridicule or likely to injure him in his
profession, office, business, trade, or occupation, whether such matter is expressed
by words, written or printed, or legibly marked on any substance, or by any object
signifying such matter otherwise than by words, and whether expressed directly
or by insinuation or irony.
(2) Publishing a criminal libel is –
(a) Exhibiting it in public; or
(b) Causing it to be read or seen, or showing or delivering it, or causing
it to be shown or delivered, with a view to its being read or seen, by
any person other than the person defamed.
(3) Every one is guilty of criminal slander who, without lawful justification
or excuse, uses any words that are likely to injure the reputation of any other
person by exposing him to hatred, contempt, or ridicule, or likely to injure him in
his profession, office, business, trade, or occupation, if the words are –
1174 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) Spoken, or reproduced from a recording, within the hearing of more than 12 persons at a meeting to which the public are invited or have access, or within the hearing of more than 12 persons in any place to which the public have or are permitted to have access; or
(b) Broadcast by means of radio.
(4) Every one who publishes a criminal libel or is guilty of criminal slander
is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months.
(5) In a prosecution under this section the burden of proof shall be
determined by the same rules as in an action for damages for defamation.
(6) In a prosecution under this section it shall be no defence that the libel
or slander is true unless the publication of it was for the public benefit.

188 Definition of theft

(1) Theft or stealing is the act of fraudulently or dishonestly taking, or
converting to the use of any person, or misappropriating or disposing of, or dealing
in any other manner with, anything capable of being stolen, with intent to defraud
or injure any person having any property or interest in that thing.
(2) Every animate or inanimate thing whatever which is the property of
any person, and is movable, is capable of being stolen.
(3) Every thing whatever which is the property of any person and is capable
of being made movable is capable of being stolen as soon as it becomes movable,
although it is made movable in order to steal it.

189 Ineffectual defences to charge of theft

Without in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing definition of
theft, a person shall be deemed guilty of theft notwithstanding the fact –
(a) That at the time of the theft he was in lawful possession of the
property stolen; or
(b) That he had himself a lawful interest in the property stolen, whether
as a partner, co-owner, bailee, bailor, mortgagee, mortgagor, or
otherwise howsoever; or
(c) That he was a trustee of the property stolen; or
(d) That the property stolen was vested in him as an executor or
administrator.

190 Extended definition of theft

Without in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing definition of
theft, every person shall be deemed guilty of theft who holds, receives, or obtains
any money, valuable security, or other thing whatsoever capable of being stolen,
subject to any obligation (whether arising from an express or implied trust, or
from an express or implied contract, or from any other source whatsoever) to deal
with the money, valuable security, or thing in any manner, and who fraudulently
or dishonestly deals with it in any other manner or fails to deal with it under that
obligation.

191 Obtaining money or goods by false pretences

Every one who by means of any fraud or false pretence dishonestly obtains
for himself or for any other person (whether directly or through the medium of
any contract procured by the fraud or false pretence) anything capable of being
stolen is guilty of stealing the thing so obtained, and shall be liable accordingly.

Niue Act 1966 1175

192 Punishment of theft

(1) Every one who commits theft is liable –
(a) To imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months if the value of
the property stolen does not exceed 4 dollars;
(b) To imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year if the value of
the property stolen exceeds 4 dollars but does not exceed 100 dollars;
(c) To imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years if the value of
the property stolen exceeds 100 dollars.
(2) In computing for the purposes of this section the value of the property
stolen, where several thefts are charged in the same information against the same
person, the aggregate value of all such property shall be computed, and the
sentence shall be determined accordingly, and cumulative sentences in respect of
the several thefts so charged shall not be imposed.
(3) For the purposes of this section a valuable security shall be deemed to
be of the same value as the property to which it relates.

193 Stealing documents

(1) Every one who destroys, cancels, conceals, or obliterates in whole or in
part any document for any fraudulent or dishonest purpose is guilty of having
stolen that document, and is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3
years.
(2) Every one who in this or any other manner steals a testamentary instrument is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 10 years.

194 Receiving stolen goods

Every one who receives any stolen property knowing it to have been stolen
is guilty of having stolen the property, and is liable accordingly.

195 Robbery

(1) Robbery is theft accompanied by violence or threats of violence to any
person or property, used to extort the property stolen or to prevent or overcome
resistance to its being stolen.
(2) Every one who commits robbery is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 10 years.
(3) Every one who assaults any person with intent to rob him is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years.

196 Conversion or attempted conversion

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years
who, unlawfully and without colour of right, but not so as to be guilty of theft,
takes or converts to his use or to the use of any other person any of the following
things –
who –
(a) Any motorcar, or any vehicle of any description; (b) Any ship;
(c) Any aircraft;
(d) Any part of any motorcar, vehicle, ship or aircraft;
(e) Any horse, mare, or gelding.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year
(a) Has in his possession by night any instrument, being an instrument capable of being used for taking or converting any of the things mentioned in subsection (1)(a) to (d), in circumstances that, prima
1176 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
facie, show an intention to use it for the taking or converting of any such thing as aforesaid;
(b) Has in his possession by day any such instrument as aforesaid with intent to take or convert any such thing as aforesaid.
(3) It is a defence to a charge under subsection (2) (a) if the person charged proves that he had lawful excuse for having the instrument in his possession.

197 Breach of trust

(1) Every trustee who with intent to defraud, and in violation of his trust,
converts anything of which he is a trustee to any use not authorised by the trust is
guilty of criminal breach of trust, and is liable to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 5 years.
(2) For the purposes of this section an executor or administrator shall be
deemed to be a trustee of the property subject to his administration.
(3) Nothing in this section shall be so construed as in any manner to limit
the foregoing definition of the offence of theft, and if any act of a trustee is both
theft and a criminal breach of trust he may be convicted of either of those offences.

198 Menaces

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
with menaces demands from any person, either for himself or for any other person,
anything capable of being stolen, with intent to steal it.

199 Witchcraft

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months
who pretends to exercise or use any kind of witchcraft, sorcery, enchantment, or
conjuration, or undertakes to tell fortunes.

200 Obtaining credit by fraud

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months
who in incurring any debt or liability obtains credit by means of any fraud.

201 Accusation of criminal offences

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years who –
(a) With intent to extort or gain anything from any person, accuses or
threatens to accuse either that person or any other person of any
criminal offence, whether the person accused or threatened with
accusation is guilty of that offence or not; or
(b) With such intent as aforesaid, threatens that any person shall be so
accused by any person; or
(c) Causes any person to receive a document containing any such
accusation or threat, knowing the contents thereof.

202 Conspiracy to defraud

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years who
conspires with any other person by deceit or falsehood or other fraudulent means
to defraud the public or any person ascertained or unascertained.

Niue Act 1966 1177

203 Obtaining execution of valuable securities by fraud

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years who
by any false pretence causes or induces any person to execute, make, accept,
endorse, or destroy the whole or any part of any valuable security.

204 Burglary

(1) Every one is guilty of burglary and is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 5 years who by day or night –
(a) Breaks and enters any building or ship with intent to commit a
crime there; or
(b) Breaks out of any building or ship either after committing a crime
there or after having entered with intent to commit a crime there.
(2) In this section –
“break”, in relation to any building or ship, means to break any part,
internal or external, of the building or ship, or to open by any means
whatsoever any door, window, or other thing intended to cover
openings to the building or ship or to give passage from one part of it
to another;
“building” means any building, erection, or structure of any description,
whether permanent or temporary, and includes a tent or a caravan,
and also includes any enclosed yard or any closed cave or tunnel.

205 Unlawful entry of dwellinghouse

(1) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years
who unlawfully enters or is in any dwellinghouse by night with intent to commit
a criminal offence there or who is found by night in any dwellinghouse without
lawful justification for his presence there.
(2) Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months
or to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who without lawful excuse (the proof
of which excuse shall be on him), but in circumstances that do not disclose the
commission of or an intention to commit any other offence, is found at any time in
any dwellinghouse, or in any enclosed yard, garden, or area or in or on board any
vessel of any kind or any aircraft.
(3) In this section –
“dwellinghouse” means –
(a) Any building, hut, tent, caravan, or other structure or erection,
whether permanent or temporary, which is used or intended to be
used in whole or in part for human habitation or occupation; or
(b) Any building, public or private, which is used or intended to be
used in whole or in part for the purpose of education or the reception
or lodging of any person for medical treatment or recuperation or
entertainment or any other purpose;
“night” means the time commencing on the expiration of the first half hour
after sunset and concluding at the beginning of the last hour before
sunrise.

205A Entering premises for a criminal purpose

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 4 years who
unlawfully enters or is in any building, ship, or aircraft with intent to commit
there any criminal offence mentioned in this Part.
1178 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

206 Threats to kill or do bodily harm

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years who
sends or causes to be received, knowing the contents of it, any letter or writing
containing threats to kill or do bodily harm to any person, or who orally makes a
threat to kill or do bodily harm to any person.

207 Forgery

(1) Forgery is the making of a false document with intent to defraud or
deceive any person, whether ascertained or unascertained.
(2) Every one who commits forgery is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 5 years.
(3) In this section “false document” means a document –
(a) Of which the whole or any material part purports to be made by
any person who did not make it or authorise its making; or
(b) Of which the whole or any material part purports to be made on
behalf of any person who did not authorise its making; or
(c) In which, though it purports to be made by the person who did in
fact make it or authorise its making, or purports to be made on
behalf of the person who did in fact authorise its making, the time
or place of its making, where either is material, or any number or
distinguishing mark identifying the document, where either is
material, is falsely stated; or
(d) Of which the whole or some material part purports to be made by
a fictitious or deceased person, or purports to be made on behalf of
any such person; or
(e) Which is made in the name of an existing person either by him or
by his authority, with the intention that it should pass as being made
by some person, real or fictitious, other than the person who makes
or authorises it.
(4) In this section, “making a false document” includes making any material
alteration in a genuine document, whether by addition, insertion, obliteration,
erasure, removal, or otherwise.
(5) Forgery is complete as soon as the document is made with such
knowledge and intent as aforesaid, although the offender may not have intended
that any particular person should use or act upon it as genuine, or should be
induced by the belief that it is genuine to do or refrain from doing anything.
(6) Forgery is complete although the false document may be incomplete,
or may not purport to be such a document as would be valid in law, if it be so
made and is such as to indicate that it was intended to be acted on as genuine.

208 Extended definition of forgery

Every one who procures the execution of any document by any person by
falsely pretending that its contents are different from what they really are is guilty
of forging that document, and is liable accordingly.

209 Making counterfeit coin

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years who
makes or begins to make counterfeit coin of New Zealand or of any other country,
or who has in his possession any dies or other instruments or materials intended
to be used in the making of such counterfeit coin.

Niue Act 1966 1179

210 Lightening coin

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years who
diminishes or lightens any coin, whether of New Zealand or of any other country,
with intent that when so dealt with it shall pass as current coin either in Niue or
New Zealand or elsewhere.

211 Uttering counterfeit coin

Every one who fraudulently utters any counterfeit coin is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months.

212 Arson

(1) Arson is the offence of wilfully, and without lawful justification and
without bona fide claim of right, setting fire to any building, ship, crop, chattel, or
other thing whatsoever, whether attached to the soil or not.
(2) Where the act done results in the destruction of or any damage to
anything in which the person accused has an interest, whether total or partial, the
existence of that interest shall not prevent his act being an offence if it is done with
intent to defraud or to cause loss to any other person. For the purposes of this
subsection, where any property is subject to any mortgage or charge, each of the
parties to the mortgage or charge shall be deemed to have a partial interest in that
property.
(3) Every one who commits the offence of arson is liable to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 5 years.

213 Wilful mischief to property

(1) Every one is guilty of an offence who wilfully and without lawful
justification and without bona fide claim of right destroys or damages any property,
whether movable or immovable.
(2) Where the act done results in the destruction of or any damage to
anything in which the person accused has an interest, whether total or partial, the
existence of that interest shall not prevent his act being an offence if it is done with
intent to defraud or to cause loss to any other person. For the purposes of this
subsection, where any property is subject to any mortgage or charge, each of the
parties to the mortgage or charge shall be deemed to have a partial interest in that
property.
(3) Every person who commits an offence against this section is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years if the damage done or intended to
be done by him amounts to $20 or more, and to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 6 months in any other case.

214 Provoking breach of the peace

Every one is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who uses any
threatening, abusive, or insulting words or behaviour in any public place with
intent to provoke a breach of the peace or whereby a breach of the peace may be
occasioned.

215 Profane, indecent, or obscene language

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or
to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who uses any profane, indecent, or obscene
language in any public place or within the hearing of any person in a public place.
1180 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

216 Disorderly conduct in public places

Every one is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who is guilty of
any disorderly conduct in any public place to the annoyance of persons there
present.

217 Obstructing public place

Every one is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who without
lawful justification obstructs any public place, or creates any source of danger in
it, or otherwise commits any public nuisance in it.

218 Drunkenness

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one month or
to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who is found drunk in any public place.

219 Animal trespass

(1) A person must not permit a horse, sheep, pig, goat, or cattle to wander
or be at large in a public place or to trespass on land.
(2) A person who fails to comply with subsection (1) is guilty of an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or for a second
or subsequent offence to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

220 Prostitution

Any prostitute is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one month
or to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who loiters and importunes any person
in any public place for the purpose of prostitution.

221 Laying poison

Every one is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who without
lawful justification places any poison in any place so as to be a source of danger to
human beings or to animals.

222 Polluting water

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or
to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit who throws any offensive matter into or
otherwise pollutes any watercourse, well, cistern, or other place from which the
supply of water for the use of the inhabitants is obtained.

223 Sale of unwholesome provisions

Every one is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one month or
to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who sells, or exposes for sale, or has in his
possession with intent to sell, any food or drink which he knows, or might by the
exercise of reasonable care have known, to be unwholesome.

224 Insanitary premises

Every one is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who permits
any premises in his occupation or belonging to him to be in an insanitary or
offensive condition to the danger or annoyance of the public or of his neighbours.

225 Wilful trespass

Every one is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who wilfully
trespasses on land in the occupation of any other person.

Niue Act 1966 1181

226 Cruelty to animals

(1) A person must not –
(a) cruelly beat, overdrive, overload, abuse, torture, or otherwise ill
treat an animal, or
(b) being the owner or having the charge of an animal –
(i) omit to supply it with proper and sufficient food, water, or
shelter; or
(ii) abandon the animal with the intention of relinquishing
ownership or charge of it.
(2) A person who fails to comply with subsection (1) is guilty of an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or for a second
or subsequent offence to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.
(3) It is not a defence for a person charged with an offence under subsection
(1)(b)(ii) to prove that the animal to which the charge relates was abandoned on
land in which that person had an interest.
(4) In this section “animal” means any beast or bird of any species whatever.

227 Falsely trading as a company

(1) Every one is liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units who uses in
connection with his trade or business any name, sign, device, or other
representation indicating or calculated to lead other persons to believe contrary
to the fact that the trade or business is that of an incorporated company.
(2) In any prosecution for an offence against this section the burden of
proving that the incorporated company exists and that the trade or business so
carried on is the trade or business of that company shall be upon the accused.

228 Conspiracy

Every one who conspires with any other person to commit any offence
punishable by imprisonment is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
half the longest term to which a person committing the said offence may be
sentenced.

228A Wrongful communication, retention or copying of official information

(1) Everyone is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 years
who –
(a) Knowingly or recklessly, and with knowledge that he is acting without proper authority, communicates any official information to any other person, or uses directly or indirectly any official information for any purpose whatsoever where such disclosure or use is contrary to the interests of Niue;
(b) Knowingly or recklessly, and with knowledge that he is acting
without proper authority, retains or copies official information, or
permits any other person to retain or copy such official information;
(c) Knowingly fails to comply with any directions issued by a lawful
authority for the return of any official information, including copies,
which is in his possession or under his control.
(2) In this section “official information” means any information held by –
(a) A department or agency of government; or
(b) A Minister of the Crown in his official capacity; or
(c) An officer or employee of any department or agency of government
in his capacity as such an officer or employee or in his capacity as a
statutory officer; or
1182 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(d) An independent contractor engaged by any department or Minister of the Crown or agency of government in his capacity as such contractor;
(e) Any committee or advisory body established for the purpose of assisting or advising or performing functions connected with any department or Minister of the Crown or agency of government.

Attempts

229 Attempts to commit offences

(1) Every one who, having an intent to commit an offence, does or omits
an act for the purpose of accomplishing his object, is guilty of an attempt to commit
the offence intended, whether in the circumstances it was possible to commit the
offence or not.
(2) The question whether an act done or omitted with intent to commit an
offence is or is not only preparation for the commission of that offence, and too
remote to constitute an attempt to commit it, is a question of law.
(3) An act done or omitted with intent to commit an offence may constitute
an attempt if it is immediately or proximately connected with the intended offence,
whether or not there was any act unequivocally showing the intent to commit
that offence.
(4) Everyone who attempts to commit an offence in respect of which no
punishment is expressly prescribed by this or any other enactment is liable to not
more than half the maximum punishment to which he would be liable if he had
committed that offence.

230 Attempt proved when offence is charged

Where the commission of the offence charged is not proved, but the evidence
establishes an attempt to commit the offence, the accused may be convicted of the
attempt.

231 Offence proved when attempt is charged

(1) Where an attempt to commit an offence is charged, but the evidence
establishes the commission of the full offence, the accused may be convicted of
the attempt.
(2) After a conviction for that attempt, the accused shall not be liable to be
tried again for the offence which he was charged with attempting to commit.

232 Inciting

Parties to Offences

(1) Every person who incites any person, whether ascertained or unascertained, to commit any offence punishable by imprisonment shall be liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding half the longest term to which a person committing the said offence may be sentenced or, where that offence is punishable by imprisonment for life, to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 14 years.
(2) If the offence to which any person is so incited is actually committed by him, the person so inciting him shall be liable, on a charge of inciting, to the same punishment as if he had himself committed the offence, or he may be charged and convicted as a party to the offence so procured by him.

Niue Act 1966 1183

233 Parties to offences

Every one is a party to and guilty of an offence who –
(a) Actually commits the offence; or
(b) Does or omits any act for the purpose of aiding any person to
commit the offence; or
(c) Abets any person in the commission of the offence; or
(d) Counsels or procures any person to commit the offence.

234 Common criminal purpose

If several persons form a common intention to prosecute any unlawful
purpose and to assist each other in it, each of them is a party to every offence
committed by any one of them in the prosecution of that common purpose, the
commission of which offence was known to be a probable consequence of the
prosecution of that common purpose.

235 Counselling or procuring

(1) Every one who counsels or procures another to be a party to an offence
of which that other is afterwards guilty is a party to that offence, although it may
be committed in a way different from that which was counselled.
(2) Every one who counsels or procures another to be a party to an offence
is a party to every offence which that other commits in consequence of that
counselling or procuring, and which the person counselling or procuring knew to
be likely to be committed in consequence of the counselling or procuring.

236 Accessory after the fact

(1) An accessory after the fact to an offence is one who, knowing any person
to have been a party to the offence, receives, comforts, or assists that person or
tampers with or actively suppresses any evidence against him, in order to enable
him to escape after arrest or to avoid arrest or conviction.
(2) No married person whose spouse has been a party to an offence shall
become an accessory after the fact to that offence by doing any act to which this
section applies in order to enable the spouse, or the spouse and any other person
who has been a party to the offence, to escape after arrest or to avoid arrest or
conviction.

237 Punishment of accessories

Every one who is accessory after the fact to any offence punishable by
imprisonment, being an offence in respect of which no express provision is made
by this Act or by some other enactment for the punishment of an accessory after
the fact, is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years if the punishment
for that offence is imprisonment for life, and not exceeding 5 years if that
punishment is imprisonment for 10 or more years; and in any other case is liable
to not more than half the maximum punishment to which he would have been
liable if he had committed the offence.

237A Children under 10

Infancy

(1) No person shall be convicted of an offence by reason of any act done or omitted by him when under the age of 10 years.
(2) The fact that by virtue of this section any person has not been or is not
liable to be convicted of an offence shall not affect the question whether any other
person who is alleged to be a party to that offence is guilty of that offence.
1184 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

237B Children between 10 and 14

(1) No person shall be convicted of an offence by reason of any act done or
omitted by him when of the age of 10 but under the age of 14 years, unless he
knew either that the act or omission was wrong or that it was contrary to law.
(2) The fact that by virtue of this section any person has not been or is not
liable to be convicted of an offence shall not affect the question whether any other
person who is alleged to be a party to that offence is guilty of that offence.

238 Common law defences

Defences

All rules and principles of the common law which render any circumstance a justification or excuse for any act or omission, or a defence to any charge, shall remain in force with respect to all offences constituted by this or any other enactment, except so far as inconsistent with this or any other enactment.

239 Common law offences

No person shall be proceeded against for any criminal offence at common
law.

Sentences

240 Power to fine instead of or in addition to imprisonment

Except where otherwise expressly provided, every one liable to
imprisonment for any term for any offence may be sentenced to pay a fine not
exceeding 2 penalty units in addition to or instead of imprisonment.

241 Enforcement of fines

(1) Every fine imposed upon any person by the High Court shall constitute
a judgment debt due by that person to the Crown, and payment of it shall be
enforceable and recoverable accordingly by writ of sale or any other civil process
of execution in the same manner in all respects as if the debt had been recovered
in civil proceedings at the suit of the Crown.
(2) Any person upon whom any such fine has been imposed may, by
warrant under the seal of the High Court, be committed to prison by a Judge of
that Court for a period not exceeding 6 months, but shall be entitled to be
discharged from imprisonment on payment of the fine.
(3) When any person has been so committed to prison, no proceedings or
further proceedings shall thereafter be taken for the enforcement of the fine by
way of civil process under this section.

242 Imprisonment in Niue

Save so far as herein otherwise provided, every sentence of imprisonment
shall be carried into effect in some prison in Niue and subject to any Act.

243 Transfer of convicted persons to New Zealand

(1) Every person sentenced to imprisonment, or committed to prison for 6
months or more including an offender who has been recalled under section 244A
may, by warrant of the Cabinet and the Seal of Niue, be transferred to some prison
in New Zealand named or described in the warrant.
(2) On the issue of any such warrant, the person named therein shall
thereupon be taken in custody from Niue to New Zealand, and there forthwith
delivered to the Superintendent of the prison named or described in the warrant.

Niue Act 1966 1185

(3) The warrant shall be delivered to the said Superintendent together with a certificate under the hand of a Judge of the High Court and the seal of that Court setting forth the fact of the conviction or commitment of the person named in the warrant, the offence of which he was convicted or the reason of the commitment, and the term for which he has been so sentenced or committed.
(4) Where any person brought to New Zealand under this section is
imprisoned in New Zealand under any of the foregoing provisions of this section –
(a) The period during which he has been in custody since the sentence
was imposed in Niue until his delivery to the Superintendent in
New Zealand shall for all purposes be computed as part of the term
of his imprisonment;
(b) Subject to section 244, he shall be imprisoned in New Zealand in
the same manner in all respects and shall be subject in all respects
to the same laws, as far as applicable, as if he had been sentenced
by the Supreme Court of New Zealand to imprisonment for the life
offence, or committed to prison by that Court on the like grounds.

244 Release of prisoners transferred to New Zealand

[This section is not Niue law. The Criminal Justice Act 1954 of New Zealand has been

replaced by the Criminal Justice Act 1985.]

(1) Where any person (in this section referred to as the offender) brought
to New Zealand under section 243 is imprisoned in New Zealand under that
section –
(a) The Minister of Justice, with the concurrence of the Minister of
Foreign Affairs –
(i) may, by warrant signed by him, grant to the offender, not being
an offender serving a sentence of life imprisonment, remission
of any part of his sentence, not exceeding one-fourth of the
term, on the ground of his good conduct and industry; and
(ii) may, where he considers that the conduct of the offender has
been exemplary during his sentence, or that the offender has
during his sentence performed some outstanding act of service,
grant to the offender, not being an offender serving a sentence
of life imprisonment, in addition to any remission which may
be granted to him under subparagraph (i), a special remission
of part of his sentence, not exceeding one-twelfth of the term;
and may revoke any such remission at any time before the
offender is released; and
(iii) may, in the case of any offender who is a Niuean, direct by
warrant signed by him that on the release of the offender he be
allowed to remain in New Zealand;
(b) Where any offender is granted a remission of any part of his sentence
under paragraph (a) then –
(i) if under this section he is to be released in New Zealand, the
Minister of Justice, with the concurrence of the Minister of
Foreign Affairs may, by warrant at any time before the offender
is released, impose such special conditions of probation in
addition to those that apply by virtue of section 38 of the
Criminal Justice Act 1954;
(ii) if under this section he is to be returned to Niue, the Minister
of Justice, with the like concurrence, may, by warrant at any
time before the offender is released for the purpose of being
1186 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
returned to Niue, direct that, until a date specified in the warrant (being a date not later than the date of expiry of the term of the original sentence), the offender shall be subject to supervision by a person to be nominated by the Premier, and shall comply with the directions of that person with respect to such matters as are specified in the warrant;
(c) The provisions of section 33A of the Criminal Justice Act 1954 as far as they are applicable but subject to the provisions of this section, shall apply with respect to the offender as if he had been sentenced to imprisonment by the High Court of New Zealand.
(2) The Prisons Parole Board, on considering the case of any offender under section 33A of the Criminal Justice Act 1954 (as so enacted), shall have regard, in addition to the matters specified in subsection (6) of that section, to such other matters of any kind whatsoever as it considers relevant in the circumstances of the case, and may recommend that the offender –
(a) Be returned to Niue and released on his arrival there; or
(b) Be returned in custody to Niue and continue to serve the sentence
of imprisonment in some prison in Niue until a date specified by
the Board (being, in the case of a prisoner undergoing a sentence of
life imprisonment, such date as the Board thinks fit, and, in the
case of any other prisoner, a date not later than 3 months after his
return to Niue) and be released on the date so specified; or
(c) Be released in New Zealand.
(3) Any recommendation of the Prisons Parole Board under subsection (2)
may be subject to such conditions as the Board thinks fit, including, if the Board
thinks fit, a condition, in the case of a prisoner to whom paragraph (a) or paragraph
(b) of that subsection applies, that, until a date specified by the Board (being, in
the case of an offender undergoing a sentence of life imprisonment, such date as
the Board thinks fit, and in any other case a date not later than the date of the
expiry of the term of the original sentence), he shall be subject to supervision by a
person to be nominated by the Premier and shall comply with the directions of
that person with respect to such matters as the Board specifies.
(4) The provisions of the Criminal Justice Act 1954 relating to the release
of an offender on probation shall not apply with respect to any offender who is
returned to Niue under this section.
(5) Where under this section any offender is released in New Zealand,
sections 35 to 39 of the Criminal Justice Act 1954, as far as they are applicable,
shall apply as if he had been so released at or before the expiry of a term of
imprisonment imposed by the High Court of New Zealand.
(6) Where any offender who under this section is released in New Zealand
desires to return to Niue before the expiration of the term of his probation, the
Minister of Justice, on the application of the offender and with the concurrence of
the Minister of Foreign Affairs, may cancel the probationary licence as from the
date on which the offender leaves New Zealand, and by warrant direct that as
from the date of the arrival of the offender in Niue until a date specified in the
warrant (being not later than the date on which the term of probation would have
expired if the probationary licence had not been cancelled) the offender shall be
subject to supervision by a person to be nominated by the Premier and shall comply
with the directions of that person with respect to such matters as are specified in
the warrant.
(7) Every offender, if he is a Niuean, shall, as soon as he is entitled to be
released or as soon thereafter as may be, unless he is to be released in New Zealand

Niue Act 1966 1187

under this section, be returned to Niue under a warrant signed by the Minister of Justice, and in the meantime shall be detained in custody in some prison in New Zealand appointed by that warrant.
(8) A recommendation of the Prisons Parole Board under this section may be given effect under a warrant signed by the Minister of Justice with the concurrence of the Minister of Foreign Affairs.
(9) For the purposes of this section, cumulative terms of imprisonment shall be treated as one term.
(10) Where any offender is for the time being subject to supervision in
Niue under this section, the term of his sentence shall continue to run while he is
subject to supervision as if he were still serving the sentence; and the date of expiry
of the sentence shall be determined accordingly.

244A Recall of offender subject to supervision

(1) Where any offender undergoing a sentence of imprisonment for life is
for the time being subject to supervision in Niue under section 244, the Court on
application of the Chief of Police may at any time before the expiration of the
period of supervision, by warrant direct that the offender be recalled.
(2) On the giving of that direction, the supervision shall be deemed to be
cancelled, and the offender may be arrested without warrant by any constable,
and, subject to section 244, shall continue to serve his original sentence.
(3) The powers conferred by subsection (1) may be exercised on such
grounds as the Court thinks fit and whether or not the offender has committed a
breach of any condition of his supervision.

245 Person conditionally released from imprisonment

(1) Any person who is released from imprisonment –
(a) Pursuant to a remission of part of his sentence under section
244(1)(a) or to a recommendation of the Prisons Parole Board under
paragraph (c) of that subsection subject to any conditions imposed
under that section, and is returned to Niue under that section
(including a person who returns to Niue under subsection (6) of
that section); or
(b) Under a remission of part of his sentence under section 286 subject
to any conditions imposed under that section –
and who commits a breach of any such condition may be arrested by any constable
without warrant and brought before a Judge of the High Court, and may be
sentenced to imprisonment, in the case of a person who was undergoing a sentence
of life imprisonment, for such period as the Court thinks fit, and in any other case
for any period not exceeding the unexpired portion of the term of his original
sentence.
(2) For the purposes of this section, cumulative terms of imprisonment
shall be treated as one term.

246 Cumulative sentences

(1) When an offender is sentenced for more offences than one at the same
time, or if, when sentenced for one offence, he has already been sentenced for any
other offence and has not yet completed the sentence so imposed upon him, the
Court may direct that the sentences passed on him for his several offences shall
take effect one after the other or concurrently.
(2) Save as provided by this section, every sentence of imprisonment shall
commence to take effect on the day on which the sentence is pronounced.
1188 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 6
CRIMINAL PROCEDURE

247 [Repealed by 2004/270]

248 Jurisdiction of High Court

Except where otherwise expressly provided, all offences against the laws
of Niue may be tried in the High Court under this Part.

249 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Preliminary Proceedings

250 Arrest without warrant

(1) No person shall be arrested without warrant except under this Act or
under some other enactment giving power to arrest without warrant.
(2) Any constable and any person whom he calls to his assistance may,
without warrant, arrest and take into custody –
(a) Any person whom he finds disturbing the public peace or whom
he has good cause to suspect is committing any offence punishable
by imprisonment;
(b) Any person whom he has good cause to suspect of having
committed a breach of the peace or any offence punishable by
imprisonment;
(c) Any person whom he has good cause to suspect to be attempting
or about to commit a breach of the peace or any offence punishable
by imprisonment;
(d) Any person whom he has good cause to suspect is committing an
offence against section 214 or section 216.
(3) Any person may, without warrant, arrest and take into custody –
(a) Any person whom, in any public place, he finds disturbing the
public peace;
(b) Any person whom he has good cause to suspect to be about to
commit, in a public place, a breach of the peace.
(4) Subsections (1) and (2) shall be read subject to the express provisions of
any enactment imposing any limitation, restriction, or condition on the exercise
of any power to arrest without warrant conferred upon any constable or any other
person in respect of any specified offence or any specified class of offences.
(5) Where under any enactment, other than this Act, any officer or other
person, not being a constable, has power without warrant, to arrest any other
person, any constable may exercise that power in the same cases and in the same
manner as that officer or other person.
(6) Where any person, other than a constable, arrests without warrant, any
other person, he shall as soon as reasonably possible thereafter deliver that other
person into the custody of a constable.

251 Arrest on warrant of Commissioner

A Commissioner, on receiving such information on oath as seems sufficient
to him, whether made in writing or not, may issue his warrant for the arrest of
any person for any offence against the laws of Niue, and thereupon any constable
or other person specified in the warrant in that behalf may arrest the accused,
who shall be forthwith brought before a Judge of the High Court or the Registrar
there to be dealt with under this Part.

Niue Act 1966 1189

251A Duty of persons arresting

(1) It is the duty of every one arresting any other person to inform the
person he is arresting, at the time of the arrest, of the act or omission for which the
person is being arrested, unless it is impracticable to do so, or unless the reason
for the arrest is obvious in the circumstances. The act or omission need not be
stated in technical or precise language, and may be stated in any words reasonably
sufficient to give that person notice of the true reason for his arrest.
(2) It is the duty of every one who arrests any other person under any
process or warrant –
(a) If he has the process or warrant in his possession at the time of the
arrest, to produce it if required by that person to do so;
(b) If he does not have the process or warrant in his possession at the
time of the arrest, to show it to the arrested person as soon as
practicable after the arrest, if that person so requires.
(3) Where under any enactment any person other than a constable has, by
virtue of his office, a power of arrest without warrant, he shall, whenever he arrests
any other person under that power –
(a) If he has evidence of his appointment to that office in his possession
at the time of the arrest, produce it if required by that person to do
so;
(b) If he does not have evidence of his appointment in his possession
at the time of the arrest, show it to the arrested person as soon as
practicable after the arrest, if that person so requires.
(4) A failure to fulfil any of the duties mentioned in subsections (1)-(3)
shall not of itself deprive the person arresting, or his assistants, of protection from
criminal responsibility, but shall be relevant to the inquiry whether the arrest might
not have been effected, or the process or warrant executed, by reasonable means
in a less violent manner.
(5) Every person who is arrested on a charge of any offence shall be brought
before the High Court, as soon as possible, to be dealt with according to law.
(6) Nothing in this section shall limit or affect the express provisions of
any enactment whereby –
(a) The burden of proving the absence of reasonable or probable cause,
or the absence of justification, for any arrest is on any person;
(b) Any person having, by virtue of his office, a power of arrest without
warrant is entitled, in any specified circumstances, to exercise that
power without the production of evidence of his appointment to
that office, or is required in exercising the power, to comply with
any specified conditions or restrictions in addition to or instead of
producing evidence of his appointment.

252 Committal for trial

(1) When any person arrested with or without warrant under the foregoing
provisions is brought before a Judge or the Registrar, the Judge or Registrar may,
after such preliminary inquiry (if any), and after giving the prisoner an opportunity
of being heard, by warrant either discharge the prisoner, or commit him to prison
to await trial by the High Court for the offence for which he was arrested, or
admit him to bail, with or without sureties, conditioned to appear before the High
Court in due course for trial for the offence.
(2) No such discharge shall amount to an acquittal so as to preclude the
prosecution and trial of the accused in the High Court for the offence for which he
was so arrested.
1190 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

253 Information

Trial by the High Court

Every prosecution in the High Court for any offence shall be commenced by an information in writing laid by a constable or any other prosecutor before a Judge or the Registrar of that Court.

254 Warrant or summons

On the commencement of any such prosecution, any Judge or Commissioner
of the High Court or any two Justices of the Peace acting together may unless the
accused is already in custody, at any time issue either a warrant for the arrest of
the accused or a summons requiring him to appear before the High Court at the
time and place specified in the summons, there to answer the charge so made
against him in the information and set out in the summons.

255 Warrant after issue of summons

Any such warrant may be at any time issued by a Judge or Commissioner
of the High Court or any two Justices of the Peace acting together, notwithstanding
the fact that a summons has been already issued to the accused as aforesaid.

255A Arrested person may be released on bail

(1) Where, under section 250 (1), any person is arrested without warrant
by a constable or some other person on the grounds that the constable or other
person suspects on reasonable grounds that the person arrested has committed
any one or more of the following offences –
(a) Wilful mischief to property; or
(b) Resisting a constable in the execution of his office; or
(c) Using profane, indecent, or obscene language; or
(d) Indecent behaviour; or
(e) Assault; or
(f) Fighting or drunkenness in a public place; or
(g) Any offence against section 205 (2) –
then, notwithstanding section 250 (2), on the arrested person being brought before
a constable in charge of any police station, the constable in charge of the police
station may release the arrested person on bail, with or without sureties,
conditioned for the appearance of the arrested person before the High Court at
such place and at such time (being not more than 3 clear days after the date of the
arrest of the arrested person) as the constable in charge of the police station specifies.
(2) Should the constable in charge of a police station not release any arrested
person on bail under subsection (1) the provisions of section 250 (2) shall apply to
that person.
(3) Where any person who has been released on bail under subsection (1)
appears before the High Court, then, on his appearance before the High Court, he
shall be deemed to be in custody.
(4) Nothing in subsection (1) shall derogate from section 257.

256 Prisoners brought before Court before commencement of prosecution

(1) When any person charged with an offence is brought before a Judge of
the High Court or any two Justices of the Peace acting together in custody, having
been arrested without warrant or on a warrant issued under section 251, the Judge
may, unless a prosecution has already commenced against the prisoner by
information as aforesaid, either discharge the prisoner, or remand him in custody
pending the commencement of a prosecution, or release him on bail, with or

Niue Act 1966 1191

without sureties, conditioned for his appearance before the High Court at such time and place as the Judge thinks fit.
(2) No discharge under this section shall amount to an acquittal so as to preclude the prosecution or trial of the prisoner for the offence for which he has been so arrested.

257 Remand

When any prosecution has been commenced in the High Court, the Court
may either remand the accused in custody or admit him to bail, with or without
sureties, conditioned to appear before the High Court at any other time or place.

258 Trial of accused in his absence

When any person who is prosecuted for an offence punishable by fine only
has been duly summoned to appear before the High Court and fails to appear
under the summons, the Court may try and sentence him for that offence in his
absence.

Assessors

259 Constitution of Court in criminal trials

Every criminal trial in the High Court shall take place before one Judge of
that Court sitting with or without assessors under the provisions of this Part.

260 Judge with assessors

On the trial of any person for any offence punishable by imprisonment for
more than 5 years, the Judge shall sit with assessors.

261 Judge without assessors

On the trial of any person on an information charging him exclusively with
an offence or offences punishable only by fine, the Judge shall sit without assessors.

262 Judge with or without assessors as he thinks fit

In all other criminal trials, the Judge shall sit without assessors, unless the
Court in its discretion orders otherwise, either on its own motion or on the
application ex parte or otherwise of either the prosecutor or the accused.

263 Order appointing assessors

Any such order may be made at any time after the commencement of the
prosecution, and whether before or during the trial; but, if made after any evidence
has been heard at the trial, all such evidence shall, except so far as repeated before
the Judge and assessors, be of no force or effect.

264 Number and qualifications of assessors

(1) The assessors shall in all cases be 6 in number, and shall be such fit and
proper persons (whether men or women) as a Judge of the Court thinks fit, subject
to any rules of Court which may be made in that behalf, to appoint by warrant
under his hand and the seal of the Court, and the consent of an assessor shall not
be requisite for his appointment.
(2) No person shall be appointed as an assessor unless he has first been
nominated by the Cabinet by warrant published in the Gazette as a person qualified
for appointment as an assessor under this Act, either generally or in respect of
any particular case or class of cases; and the Cabinet may accordingly nominate in
this behalf such and so many persons as the Cabinet thinks qualified by reason of
1192 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
their character, education, ability, or reputation to hold that office, and may at any time in like manner revoke any such nomination.

265 Default of assessors

If any person so appointed as an assessor, and having had reasonable notice
of the time and place of the trial, fails without reasonable excuse duly to attend at
the trial or at any adjournment of it, or duly to make oath as such, or duly to act as
assessor throughout the trial, he shall be guilty of contempt of the High Court.

266 Remuneration of assessors

Every assessor shall be entitled to receive from the Niue Government
Account such remuneration or allowances in respect of his services as may be
authorised by the Judge at the trial in conformity with any rules of Court which
may be made in that behalf.

267 Oath of assessors

Before an assessor commences to act as such, he shall in open court and in
the presence of the accused make oath to act well and truly as assessor and to
decide in accordance with the evidence and with law.

268 Change of assessors

At any time after the appointment of an assessor and before he has been
sworn as aforesaid, a Judge of the Court may, either of his own motion or on the
application ex parte or otherwise of the prosecutor or the accused, if he is satisfied
there is any reasonable and sufficient objection to that assessor, remove him and
appoint another assessor in his place.

269 Discharge of assessors and new trial

(1) If at any time after the commencement of the trial and before judgement
the Judge is of the opinion that, owing to the misbehaviour of any assessor, or to
the death, illness, or absence of any assessor, or to any accident or misadventure,
or to any other sufficient cause, a new trial is necessary in the interests of justice,
he may discharge the assessors and order a new trial accordingly.
(2) Every such new trial shall take place before the same or another Judge
with assessors in the same manner as if no previous trial had taken place.

270 Concurrence of assessors

On a trial with assessors, no person shall be convicted by the Judge of any
offence, unless the conviction is concurred in by not less than 4 of the assessors.

271 Concurrence of Judge

If the Judge is of opinion that the accused should not be convicted, or if
fewer than 4 of the assessors concur in his conviction, the accused shall be acquitted.

272 Sentence

The concurrence of assessors in the sentence to be passed by the Judge
shall not be necessary.

Niue Act 1966 1193

273 Concurrence of assessors necessary for conviction

The concurrence of the assessors shall not be necessary for any other act of
the Court or the Judge other than conviction, and in all other respects the
jurisdiction of the Court shall be exercised by the Judge in the same manner as if
he was sitting without assessors.

Miscellaneous Provisions

274 Alternative and cumulative charges

(1) Subject to this section, in any prosecution in the High Court the
information of the prosecutor may relate to 2 or more distinct offences, whether
alternative or cumulative.
(2) No information for the offence of murder shall charge any other offence
except manslaughter.
(3) No information for the offence of rape shall charge any other offence
except indecent assault and an attempt to commit rape.

275 Relation between information and conviction

On an information for any offence the accused may be convicted either of
the offence charged in the information or of any offence which is included within
the offence so charged and which might lawfully have been charged in the same
information.

276 Withdrawal of information

(1) An information in the High Court for any offence may at any time,
whether before or during the trial, be withdrawn by the prosecutor with the leave
of a Judge of the Court, but not otherwise.
(2) An information so laid and withdrawn shall not operate as a bar to any
further proceedings against the accused in respect of the same offence.

277 Drawing up of conviction

(1) On the conviction of any person of any offence before the High Court,
a minute or memorandum of the conviction shall thereupon be drawn up and
preserved as a record of the Court, and a formal conviction under the seal of the
Court may be drawn up at any time afterwards when it becomes necessary.
(2) In the meantime the conviction and sentence may be carried into
execution, and shall have the same force and effect in every respect as if the
conviction had been formally drawn up under the seal of the Court.

278 Defects of information, summons, or warrant

(1) No objection shall be taken or allowed to any information, summons,
or warrant in any criminal proceedings before the High Court for any alleged
defect in it in substance or in form, or for any variance between the information,
summons, or warrant and the evidence adduced at the trial.
(2) The High Court may at any stage of the trial amend the information in
such manner as it thinks fit in respect of any such defect or variance.
(3) Where under subsection (2) any information is amended by substituting
one offence for another, the following provisions shall apply:
(a) Subject to paragraphs (b) and (c), the trial shall be continued as if
the accused had originally been charged with the substituted
offence;
1194 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) Before the trial is continued, the substance of the information as amended shall be stated to the accused and he shall be asked how he pleads; and, if he pleads guilty, the High Court may convict him or deal with him in any other manner authorised by law;
(c) Any evidence already given shall be deemed to have been given in and for the purposes of the trial of the information as amended, but either party shall have the right to examine or cross-examine or re-examine any witness whose evidence has already been given in respect of the offence originally charged.
(4) The High Court may, at the request of the accused, if it is of opinion that he would be embarrassed in his defence by reason of any amendment made or proposed to be made under this section, adjourn the trial.

279 Payment of witnesses

Any witness at a criminal trial may, if the Judge thinks fit and certifies
accordingly, be paid out of the Niue Government Account such allowance for his
expenses and loss of time as is so certified, subject to such rules of Court as may
be made in that behalf.

280 Court may order convicted person to come up for sentence

(1) The Court, on convicting an accused person of an offence under any
enactment, may, having regard to the circumstances, including the nature of the
offence and the character of the offender, instead of passing sentence, order the
offender to appear for sentence if called upon to do so, on such conditions as it
thinks fit, including, if the Court thinks fit, a condition that the offender shall be
subject to supervision for such period as the Court specifies, not exceeding the
period specified in or under subsection (3), by a person to be nominated by the
Chief of Police.
(2) The making of an order under this section shall not limit or affect the
power of the Court, under any enactment applicable to the offence, to make any
order for the payment of costs, damages, or compensation, or for the restitution of
any property, notwithstanding that the offender is not sentenced on conviction,
and the provisions of every such enactment shall apply accordingly.
(3) Any person in respect of whom an order is made under this section
may be called upon to appear for sentence within any period specified by the
Court in the order, being a period not exceeding 3 years from the date of the
conviction, or if no period is so specified, within one year from the date of the
conviction.
(4) Where any person is brought up for sentence under this section, the
Court may, after inquiry into the circumstances of the case and the conduct of the
offender since the order was made, sentence or otherwise deal with the offender
for the offence in respect of which the order was made.

281 Conviction without sentence or discharge without conviction

(1) If on any criminal trial the Court thinks that the charge, though proved,
is in the particular case of so trifling a nature or was committed under such
circumstances that no punishment should be imposed, the Court may convict the
accused and discharge him without sentence, either unconditionally or on such
conditions as the Court thinks fit to impose.
(2) If any person who is so convicted and discharged on conditions commits
any breach of those conditions, he shall be guilty of an offence punishable in the
same manner as the offence of which he was so previously convicted.

Niue Act 1966 1195

(3) Without limiting the powers conferred on the High Court by subsection (1), where any person is accused of any offence, the High Court, after inquiry into the circumstances of the case, may discharge him without convicting him, unless by any enactment applicable to the offence a minimum penalty is expressly provided for. A discharge under this subsection shall be deemed to be an acquittal. (4) The High Court, when discharging any person under subsection (3),
may, if it is satisfied that the charge is proved against him, make any order for the payment of costs, damages, or compensation, or for the restitution of any property, that it could have made under any enactment applicable to the offence with which he is charged if it had convicted him and sentenced him, and the provisions of every such enactment shall apply accordingly.

282 Bail

(1) When any person is admitted to or released on bail under this Act or
under any other enactment, he shall, with or without sureties, enter into a bail
bond in favour of the Government in such sum as may be required, conditioned
in such manner as may be appropriate to the particular case and as may be required.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) Every such bond shall be taken by and before a Judge of the High Court,
or the Registrar of the High Court, or, where a person is released on bail under
section 255A, by a constable in charge of the police station.
(4) Every such bond shall be signed by the person admitted to or released
on bail and by his sureties (if any) and the signature of that person and of each of
his sureties (if any) shall be attested by a Judge of the High Court, the Registrar of
the High Court, or a constable.
(5) When any person is admitted to or released on bail, the Judge of the
High Court, or constable admitting or releasing him may require him to deposit
with that Judge, or constable or with the Registrar of the High Court a sum of
money (being not greater than the amount of the recognisance entered into in the
bond). Any such sum so deposited with a Judge, or constable shall, as soon as
reasonably possible after the deposit, be paid by the person with whom it was
deposited to the Registrar of the High Court.
(6) Where any person admitted to or released on bail has fully performed
the conditions of his bond, the bond shall be void and any sum deposited by him
under subsection (5) shall be forthwith repaid to him but without any interest.
(7) Where any person admitted to or released on bail fails to perform any
condition of his bond, the Registrar of the High Court shall fix a place and time at
and on which the High Court may consider the estreat of the bond, and shall, not
less than 7 clear days before the time fixed, cause to be served on the person
admitted or released on bail (if he can be found) and upon the sureties (if any)
notice that, unless at the place and time fixed some person bound by the bond
proves to the satisfaction of the High Court that it ought not to be estreated, the
bond may be estreated.
(8) (a) If at the time and place fixed by the Registrar under subsection (7)
no sufficient cause to the contrary is shown, the High Court, on
proof of non-performance of the bond, may make an order to estreat
the bond to such amount as it thinks fit as to any person bound
thereby upon whom notice is proved to have been served in
accordance with subsection (7) and the whole or any part of any
sum deposited under subsection (5) may (but otherwise without
prejudice to the rights of the Government under the estreated bond)
be forfeited accordingly to the Government.
1196 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) If the Court is satisfied that the person admitted to or released on bail cannot be found, it may estreat the bond as against him, notwithstanding that the notice has not been served on him.
(c) No bail bond shall be estreated save by a Judge of the Court.
(9) Any sum payable in connection with any estreated bond shall be
recoverable as if it were a fine.
(10) Where any person has been admitted to or released on bail, any
surety under the bail bond entered into by that person may, at any time and at any
place, without warrant arrest and seize that person while he is not in the custody
of the law and deliver him into the custody of a constable and, on any such delivery,
the surety shall cease to be liable under the bond.

283 [Repealed by 2004/270]

284 Search warrants

(1) Any Judge or the Registrar of the High Court who is satisfied on the
oath of any person that there is reasonable ground for believing that there is in
any building, ship, aircraft, receptable, or place –
(a) Anything which there is reasonable ground to believe will afford
evidence as to the commission of any offence; or
(b) Anything in respect of which any offence has been or is suspected
of having been committed; or
(c) Anything which there is reasonable grounds for believing to be
intended to be used for the purpose of committing any offence –
may, by warrant under his hand, authorise some constable or other officer of the
Niue Public Service to search the building, ship, aircraft, receptable, or place for
any such thing, and to seize and bring it before the person by whom the warrant
has been issued.
(2) Every such warrant shall be executed by day (that is to say, after sunrise
and before sunset), unless the warrant expressly authorises the execution of it by
night.
(3) Every such warrant may be executed by reasonable force if necessary. (4) When any such thing is seized and brought before the person by whom
the warrant was issued, he may either order it to be detained for the purpose of evidence on the trial of any person for any such offence as aforesaid or may direct it to be delivered to any person believed by the person so issuing the warrant to be entitled to it.
(5) No such order of delivery shall in any manner affect the right of any
person to the ownership or possession of the thing.
(6) Any thing so ordered to be detained as evidence of an offence may be
detained under the order for such time as is reasonably necessary for the purpose
of any proceedings instituted or to be instituted in respect of the offence.

284A Power to enter premises to arrest offender or prevent offence

(1) Where any constable is authorised by this Act or by any other enactment
to arrest any person without warrant, that constable, and all persons whom he
calls to his assistance, may enter on any premises, by reasonable force if necessary,
to arrest that person if the constable –
(a) Has found that person committing any offence punishable by
imprisonment and is freshly pursuing that person; or
(b) Has good cause to suspect that that person has committed any such
offence on those premises.

Niue Act 1966 1197

(2) Any constable, and all persons whom he calls to his assistance, may enter on any premises, by reasonable force if necessary, to prevent the commission of any offence that would be likely to cause immediate and serious injury to any person or property, if he believes, on reasonable and probable grounds, that any such offence is about to be committed.
(3) If, in any case to which this section applies, the constable is not in
uniform and any person in actual occupation of the premises requires him to
produce evidence of his authority, he shall before entering on the premises produce
his badge or other evidence that he is a constable.
(4) Nothing in this section shall affect in any way the power of any constable
to enter any premises under a warrant.

285–286 [Repealed by 2004/270]

286A Parole Board

(1) There is established a Parole Board consisting of 3 members who are to
be appointed by Cabinet.
(2) Cabinet may appoint a Parole Board member under subsection (1) for
a term not exceeding 3 years.
(3) Cabinet may appoint the Chairperson of the Board.
(4) A Parole Board member appointed under subsection (1) may be
reappointed.
(5) A Parole Board member appointed under subsection (1) may resign by
written notice given to Cabinet.
(6) The appointment of a Parole Board member appointed under subsection
(1) may be terminated by Cabinet for misconduct, inefficiency or inability.

287 Compensation for loss of property

(1) On the conviction of any person for any offence, the High Court may
order the offender to pay to any person such sum as it thinks fit by way of
compensation for any loss of or damage to property suffered by that person through
or by means of the offence.
(2) Where on the arrest of the offender any money was taken from him,
the High Court may order the whole or any part of the money to be applied to any
such payment.
(3) Any order for payment under this section may be enforced in the same
manner as a fine.
(4) An order under this section shall not affect the right of any person to
recover by civil proceedings any sum in excess of the amount recovered under the
order.

288 Definitions

In this Part –
PART 7
LAW OF EVIDENCE
“Court” includes any person acting in any judicial capacity or having by law or by consent of parties authority to hear, receive, and examine evidence;
“proceedings” includes any action, trial, inquiry, cause, or matter, whether civil or criminal, depending or to be inquired of or determined in or by any Court.
1198 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

289 Discretionary power to admit or reject evidence

(1) Subject to this Act, a Court may in any proceedings admit and receive
such evidence as it thinks fit, and accept and act on such evidence as it thinks
sufficient, whether that evidence is or is not admissible or sufficient at common
law.
(2) A Court may in any proceedings refuse to receive any evidence, whether admissible or not at common law, which it considers irrelevant, or needless, or unsatisfactory as being hearsay or other secondary evidence.

290 All witnesses competent

Subject to this Part no witness in any proceedings shall be deemed
incompetent by reason of interest or on any other ground whatever.

291 Evidence of parties and their spouses

In any civil proceedings the parties and the persons on whose behalf the
proceedings are brought or defended, and the husbands and wives of those parties
or persons respectively, shall be competent and compellable to give evidence on
behalf of either or any of the parties to the proceedings.

292 Evidence of accused persons and their spouses

(1) Every person charged with any offence shall be a competent but (except
where the contrary is expressly provided by any enactment) not a compellable
witness upon his trial for that offence.
(2) The wife or husband of any person charged with an offence shall be a
competent witness on the trial of that person, but shall not be a compellable witness,
except in the following cases –
(a) When called as a witness by the accused;
(b) When the offence of which the accused is charged is an offence
against the wife or husband of the accused or against a child of the
accused.
(3) If any witness who under this section is competent but not compellable
gives evidence on any such trial, he shall be liable to cross-examination in the
same manner as if he were a compellable witness, whether the matter on which
he is so cross-examined arises out of his examination in chief or not.

293 Cross-examination as to credit

In any proceedings the Court may limit in any manner and to any extent
which it thinks fit the cross-examination of any witness as to credit, and shall
refuse to permit any such cross-examination which is needlessly offensive or
injurious to the witness, having regard to the nature or gravity of the imputations
made against him, to the importance of his evidence, and to the effect of those
imputations upon his credibility.

294 Criminating questions

Nothing in this Part shall take away or affect the privilege of any witness to
refuse to answer any question which may tend to criminate him.

295 Evidence of prisoners

(1) On application made in that behalf by any person who states on oath
that any prisoner can give material evidence in any proceedings in any Court, a
Judge of the High Court may, by order under his hand, require the prisoner to be
brought up for examination as a witness in the proceedings.

Niue Act 1966 1199

(2) In every such case the Judge may, before making such an order, require the applicant to deposit a sum sufficient to pay the expense of bringing up the prisoner, maintaining him while out of prison, and returning him thither, including the expense of his custody in the meantime.

296 Judicial notice of enactments

In all proceedings the Court shall take judicial notice of all enactments.

297 Judicial notice of seals

In every proceeding the Court shall take judicial notice of the Seal of Niue
and of the seal of any Court, officer, or other person authorised or required by law
to use any such seal, and of the signature of any Judge or any officer, whether
judicial or not, of the Niue Public Service, and of the Public Seal of New Zealand,
and of the signature of the Governor-General.

298 Power to administer oaths

All Courts are hereby empowered to administer an oath to all such witnesses
as are lawfully called or voluntarily come before them, or to take the affirmation
of any such witness instead of an oath.

299 Form of oath

Except when the person making the oath consents to any other form of
oath, an oath shall, whether in judicial or other proceedings, be made in the
following form:
The officer administering the oath shall address to the person making the
oath the following words: “Do you swear by Almighty God that the evidence you
are about to give touching the matter now before the Court shall be the truth, the
whole truth, and nothing but the truth?”, or words to the like effect, and the person
making the oath shall thereupon, while holding in his hand a copy of the Bible,
Old Testament, or New Testament, indicate his assent to the oath so administered
by uttering the words “I do”, or other words to the like effect.

300 Absence of religious belief

Where an oath has been duly made, the fact that the person making it had
at the time of making it no religious belief shall not for any purpose affect the
validity of the oath.

301 Affirmation may be made instead of oath

Every person shall be entitled as of right to make his solemn affirmation
instead of an oath in cases in which an oath is required or allowed by law, and that
affirmation shall be of the same force and effect as an oath.

302 Form of affirmation

The officer administering an affirmation shall address to the person making
the affirmation the following words: “Do you solemnly, sincerely, and truly declare
and affirm that the evidence you are about to give touching the matter before the
Court shall be the truth, the whole truth, and nothing but the truth?” or words to
the like effect, and the person making the affirmation shall thereupon indicate his
assent to the affirmation so administered by uttering the words “I do” or other
words to the like effect.
1200 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

303 Evidence of children without oath

In any proceedings all witnesses who are or appear to be under the age of
12 years may be examined without oath, but any such witness shall in that case be
required before being examined to make the following declaration: “I promise to
speak the truth, the whole truth, and nothing but the truth”, or a declaration to
the like effect; and such a declaration shall be of the same force and effect as if the
witness had taken an oath.

304 Necessity of oath

Subject to this Act, all witnesses in any judicial proceedings, civil or criminal,
shall be examined on oath.
PART 8
EXTRADITION

Extradition from Niue to New Zealand or to the Cook Islands

305 Arrest in Niue of fugitive offenders from New Zealand or the Cook

Islands

When a warrant has been lawfully issued by any competent authority in
New Zealand or in the Cook Islands for the arrest of any person and that person is
suspected of being in Niue or of being about to come into Niue, a Judge of the
High Court may, if he is satisfied in any manner that the warrant has been issued,
and whether it has been produced to him or not, issue his warrant for the arrest of
that person in Niue, and that warrant shall be addressed to such person or persons
as the Judge thinks fit.

306 Order of return to New Zealand or to the Cook Islands

On the arrest of any person under warrant so issued by a Judge of the High
Court, the person so arrested shall be forthwith brought before the High Court,
which may, on production of the original warrant issued in New Zealand or in the
Cook Islands, order the return of that person to New Zealand or to the Cook Islands.

307 Refusal of order in case of hardship

The High Court may refuse to make any such order if, having regard to the
nature of the charge or to the circumstances of the case, the Court is of the opinion
that the return of that person to New Zealand or to the Cook Islands would be the
cause of undue hardship or would otherwise be unjustifiable or inexpedient.

308 Imprisonment or release pending return

Pending the making of any such order of return, or pending the return of
any such person to New Zealand or to the Cook Islands, the High Court may
either commit him to prison or admit him to bail in such manner and on such
conditions as the Court thinks fit.

309 Release on security instead of return

(1) Instead of making such an order of return, the High Court may release
that person on bail conditioned for the payment of such sum or sums of money or
the performance of such conditions with relation to the matters in respect of which
the original warrant was issued in New Zealand or the Cook Islands as the High
Court thinks fit.
(2) On any breach of the conditions on which that person has been so
released, he may be again arrested in Niue under a warrant issued by a Judge of

Niue Act 1966 1201

the High Court, and an order for his return to New Zealand or to the Cook Islands may be made in the same manner as if he had not been so released.

310 [Repealed by 2004/270]

311 Cancellation of order of return

If any person so ordered to be returned to New Zealand or to the Cook
Islands is not returned under the order within a reasonable time after its making,
the High Court may cancel the order.

Extradition from New Zealand to Niue

[Sections 312-317 and 319 are not Niue law]

312 Arrest in New Zealand of fugitive offenders from Niue

When a warrant has been lawfully issued by any competent authority in
Niue for the arrest of any person, and that person is suspected of being in New
Zealand or of being about to come into New Zealand, a District Court Judge in
New Zealand may, if he is satisfied in any manner that the warrant has been issued,
and whether it has been produced to him or not, issue his warrant for the arrest of
that person in New Zealand, and that warrant shall be addressed to such person
or persons as the Judge thinks fit.

313 Order of return to Niue

On the arrest of any person under any warrant so issued by a District Court
Judge, the person so arrested shall be forthwith brought before a District Court
Judge in New Zealand, who may, on the production of the original warrant issued
in Niue, order the return of that person to Niue.

314 Judicial notice of signature to warrant

On making any such order, the District Court Judge may take judicial notice
of the signature to the warrant issued in Niue, and may receive such evidence as
he thinks fit, whether legally admissible in other proceedings or not.

315 Refusal of order in case of hardship

A District Court Judge may refuse to make any such order if, having regard
to the nature of the charge or to the circumstances of the case, the District Court
Judge is of opinion that the return of that person to Niue would be the cause of
undue hardship or would otherwise be unjustifiable or inexpedient.

316 Imprisonment or release pending return

Pending the making of any such order of return, or pending the return of
any such person to Niue, a District Court Judge may either commit him to prison
or admit him to bail in such manner and on such conditions as the District Court
Judge thinks fit.

317 Release on security instead of return

(1) Instead of making such an order of return, the District Court Judge
may release that person on bail conditioned for the payment of such sum or sums
of money or the performance of such conditions with relation to the matter in
respect of which the original warrant was issued in Niue as the District Court
Judge thinks fit.
(2) On any breach of the conditions on which that person has been so
released, he may be again arrested in New Zealand under a warrant issued by a
1202 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
District Court Judge, and an order for his return to Niue may be made in the same manner as if he had not been so released.

318 Return to Niue in custody

Any person against whom an order to return to Niue has been so made
shall, so soon as practicable thereafter, be taken from New Zealand to Niue in the
custody of such person as a District Court Judge may approve, and shall on arrival
in Niue be there delivered into lawful custody, to be dealt with in the same manner
as if he had been arrested in Niue under the original warrant issued there for his
arrest.

319 Cancellation of order of return

If any person so ordered to be returned to Niue is not returned under the
order within a reasonable time after the making of it, a District Court Judge or a
Judge of the High Court of New Zealand may cancel the order for his return.

Application of Extradition Act to Niue

320 Extradition Act in force in Niue

Subject to this Act, the Extradition Act 1965, so far as it is applicable, shall
extend to and be in force in Niue.

321 [Repealed by 2004/270]

322 [Repealed by 1974/64]

PART 9

323–334 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 10

335–385 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 11

386–404 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 12

405–414 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 13

415–430 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 14

431–460 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 15

Niue Act 1966 1203

PART 16
LAND DEVELOPMENT

461 Application of this Part

(1) The Court may, with the consent of the Leveki Mangafaoa or a majority
of the owners, by order declare that any Niuean land shall be subject to this Part
for such period as may be defined in that order, and the period fixed by the order
may be extended by the Court.
(2) The Court may by order direct that any land shall be no longer subject
to this Part, and thereupon the Cabinet shall cease to have any right of control in
respect of it, but without releasing the land or any of the parties from any antecedent
liability incurred to or by the Cabinet and the Cabinet may, notwithstanding the
order of the Court, continue to exercise the Cabinet’s powers of creation and
enforcement of charges hereunder so long as any such liability remains.

462 Cabinet may cultivate land on behalf of owners

(1) Where any land has been declared by the Court to be subject to this
Part, the Cabinet may, subject to any lease, licence, or other alienation to which
the land is subject, cultivate, use, and manage the whole or any part or parts of the
land, and may carry on any agricultural business or any other business or
occupation connected with the land and the produce of it on behalf of and for the
benefit of the Leveki Mangafaoa or the owners or such Niueans as may be interested
in the business carried on.
(2) For the purpose of such business, the Cabinet may –
(a) Purchase or otherwise acquire implements or other personal
property as the Cabinet thinks expedient, and may also sell or
otherwise dispose of all crops or other personal property acquired,
held, grown, or produced by the Cabinet in the course of the
business;
(b) Provide, erect, maintain, and equip stores, factories, sheds, offices,
or buildings of any kind;
(c) Do all other things reasonably necessary for the development and
operation of the business, and for the improvement of the land.
(3) The Public Service Commission may employ all such servants or agents
as the Cabinet thinks necessary for this section.
(4) (a) The Cabinet may enter into an agreement in writing with any Leveki

Mangafaoa for farming, or farming on shares, or cropping on shares

with reference to any land being administered or dealt with under
this Part, for such period and upon such conditions as to
remuneration or otherwise as the Cabinet thinks fit.
(b) Any such agreement shall be in the name of the Cabinet and shall
be as effective as if the Cabinet were the legal owner of the land
mentioned in it.
(5) The Cabinet may retain any part of the revenue derived from the
operation of any business as a reserve fund for expenditure in the management of
the business and may, as the Cabinet thinks fit, either expend the reserve fund
accordingly or may apply it or any part of it in any other manner under this Part.
(6) The Cabinet may expend such sum or sums as the Cabinet considers
expedient for the purposes of carrying on any business.
(7) The Cabinet shall be entitled to make a reasonable charge for
administration, and all expenses and liabilities (including administration expenses)
incurred by the Cabinet in the conduct of any business shall be a charge upon the
revenue received by the Cabinet from the business as well as upon the lands on
which the business is conducted.
1204 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(8) The Cabinet may make advances to the Leveki mangafaoa or any Niuean beneficiary in respect of the Cabinet’s share or interest in the profits of the business, either by way of anticipation or otherwise.
(9) (a) All sums of money advanced by the Cabinet whether on account of the business generally or to the Leveki Mangafaoa or any owner, shall constitute a charge upon the land and shall bear interest at such rate as the Cabinet shall determine.
(b) The High Court may make separate orders evidencing any charge in respect of different pieces of land or in respect of different parts of or interests in any piece of land, and for that purpose may apportion, in such manner and in such proportions as it thinks just and equitable, any money secured or proposed to be secured by any charge.
(10)(a) The provisions of any enactment prohibiting the assignment of rents or profits shall apply to all advances or other money which are or may become payable to the Leveki Mangafaoa or any owner in respect of his share or interest in the profits of the business.
(b) No person other than the Leveki Mangafaoa or a Niuean beneficiary
shall be capable of acquiring any beneficial interest except by will
or by order of the Court in any crops or chattels held by the Cabinet
or in any revenue derived or to arise therefrom, nor shall the interest
of the Leveki Mangafaoa or the beneficial interest of any Niuean
beneficiary be liable to be taken in execution or attached or become
assets in the bankruptcy of a Niuean beneficiary.
(11) Nothing in any Act prohibiting alienation by way of security shall
apply to any land that is subject to this Part.

463 Disposal of revenues received by Cabinet

All revenues received by the Cabinet from any land subject to this Part or
from any business carried on under this Part shall be applied as follows –
(a) In defraying the cost of the administration of the land or business;
(b) In paying all rates, taxes, and other assessments and outgoings
payable by the Cabinet in respect of the land or business;
(c) In the discharge, to such extent as may be required or as the Cabinet
thinks fit, of any mortgage, charge, encumbrance, or liability to
which the land or business is subject;
(d) In payment of sums (if any) set apart to meet any charge for
improvements made upon the land;
(e) For any other purposes in connection with the administration,
improvement, and settlement of the land from which the revenues
are derived, or for any other purposes of general utility to the Leveki

Mangafaoa or the Niuean owners of that land;

(f) In paying at the times and in the manner prescribed the residue of
the revenues to the Leveki Mangafaoa or the Niuean owners or other
persons having any estate or interest in the land or business in
accordance with their respective interests.

464 Money to be paid out of or into Niue Government Account

(1) All money expended or advanced by the Cabinet under this Part shall
be paid out of the Niue Government Account.
(2) All money received by the Cabinet under this Part shall be paid into
the Niue Government Account.

Niue Act 1966 1205

465 [Repealed by 1974/74]

466 Interference and obstruction prohibited

(1) Except with the consent of Cabinet, no person shall be entitled to exercise
any rights of ownership in respect of any land that is subject to this Part.
(2) Every person is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3
months or to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who –
(a) Wilfully trespasses on any such land, and neglects or refuses to
leave the land after being warned to do so by any person authorised
in that behalf by the Cabinet;
(b) Wilfully obstructs, hinders, or delays any officer, servant, or
workman in the performance or intended performance of his duties
under this Part, or otherwise obstructs or interferes with the carrying
out of any works under this Part.
(3) In any proceedings for an offence against this section in respect of any
land, the fact that the defendant has an interest in the land shall not be a defence.
(4) No proceedings shall be commenced under this section except with
the consent of the Cabinet.

467 [Repealed by 1974/74]

468 –483 [Repealed by 1971/71]

PART 17

484–488 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 18

489 Wills of Niueans

PART 19
NIUEAN SUCCESSION
No will made by a Niuean shall have any force or effect with respect to his interest in Niuean land.

490 Succession to deceased Niueans

Subject to Part 8 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 and to every
other enactment, the persons entitled on the death of a Niuean to succeed to his
estate (other than an interest in Niuean land) so far as not disposed of by his will,
and the shares in which they are so entitled, shall be determined under Niuean
custom, so far as such custom extends, and shall be determined, so far as there is
no Niuean custom applicable to the case under the Administration Act 1969.

491 Niuean land not to vest in administrator

The interest of a Niuean in Niuean land shall in no case vest in his
administrator by virtue of letters of administration.

492–496 [Repealed by 1968/68]

497 Niuean land not assets for payment of debts

The interest of any person in Niuean land shall not upon his death be assets
available for the payment of his debts and liabilities, whether to the Crown or
otherwise, but this section shall not affect the operation of any charge to which
that land is subject at the death of the deceased.
1206 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

498 [Repealed by 2004/270]

499 [Repealed]

PART 20
TRUSTEES FOR NIUEANS

500 Definition of “person under disability”

In this Part, “person under disability” means any person who is a minor, or
of unsound mind, or in prison, or who is subject to any physical or mental infirmity
which in the opinion of the Court renders him unfit to have the management of
his property.

501 Trustee orders

If any Niuean, being a person under disability, is entitled to any interest in
any property (other than an interest in Niuean land), the Court may on the
application of that person or of any other person, make an order (a trustee order)
appointing any person or persons to be the trustee or trustees of the person so
under disability in respect of the property or any part of it to which he is so entitled
(the trust property).

502 Matters to be set forth in trustee orders

(1) Every trustee order shall state the nature of the disability of the
beneficiary and, if that disability consists in minority, the order shall state the age
of the beneficiary.
(2) Except where the order states the day of the birth of the beneficiary,
any such statement as to his age shall be construed as meaning that he attained
that age on the date of the order, but it shall not be necessary for the Court in
making any such order to make any inquiry as to the day of the birth of the
beneficiary.
(3) Any such statement as to the age of the beneficiary may be amended,
but, notwithstanding any error in that statement, every act done at any time by
the trustee shall be as valid as if the statement for the time being contained in the
trustee order was correct, and no act done by the beneficiary in respect of the
property comprised in the order after the date indicated in it as the date of his
majority shall be invalidated on the ground that the beneficiary was not in fact of
the age of 21 years.
(4) Every trustee order shall define the nature of the property in respect of
which it was made and the nature of the interest of the beneficiary in it.

503 Appointment of new trustees

(1) Where it is made to appear to the Court that it is expedient to appoint
a new trustee, the Court may, by a trustee order, appoint a new trustee or new
trustees either in substitution for or in addition to any existing trustee, and whether
there is any existing trustee or not at the time of making the order.
(2) Any person so appointed shall, unless otherwise provided by the order,
have the same powers as if appointed by the original order.

504 Orders restricting powers of trustees

By a trustee order or by any subsequent order, the Court may prohibit or
restrict the exercise by the trustee of any powers which would otherwise be vested
in him under this Act, and the Court may remove or vary any such prohibition or
restriction.

Niue Act 1966 1207

505 Cancellation of trustee orders

The Court may make an order cancelling or varying a trustee order.

506 Determination of trustee orders

When a trustee order has been made on the ground of the minority of the
beneficiary, the powers of the trustee shall cease and determine, without any order
in that behalf, so soon as the beneficiary attains his majority, and the trustee order
shall thereupon cease to be in force.

507 Trust property not to vest in trustee

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any rule of law or equity, the
trust property shall not vest in a trustee appointed by a trustee order, but shall
remain vested in the beneficiary for the same estate and interest as if no such
order had been made.

508 Administration of property by trustee

Subject to this Part and to any order of the Court to the contrary, every such
trustee shall be entitled to the possession, receipt, and administration of the trust
property and of all revenues to be derived from it, and he shall in the exercise of
all powers conferred upon him by this Act be deemed to be the agent of the
beneficiary.

509 Alienation of property by trustee

(1) Except so far as expressly provided by order of the Court, any such
trustee shall, in respect of the alienation or other disposition of any property
included in the trust (other than an alienation or disposition by will), represent
the beneficiary, and may accordingly exercise in the name and on behalf of the
beneficiary all powers in respect of the alienation or other disposition of any such
property which the beneficiary might himself have exercised had he been under
no disability and had no such trustee been appointed.
(2) So long as any trustee order remains in force, the beneficiary shall not
be capable of exercising any powers in respect of the alienation or disposition of
the trust property, other than a disposition by will if he is possessed of testamentary
capacity.

510 Powers of trustee

Except so far as otherwise provided by order of the Court, any such trustee
may do, in the name and on behalf of the beneficiary, all things in relation to the
trust property which he considers necessary or expedient for the advantageous
administration of that property in the interests of the beneficiary, and which the
beneficiary could himself have done had he been under no disability and had no
such trustee been appointed.

511 Expenditure of revenues of trust property

(1) The Court may make such orders for the payment or expenditure of
any of the revenues of the trust property to or for the benefit of the beneficiary, or
for the maintenance of the children, adopted children, wife, or husband of the
beneficiary.
(2) The right of the beneficiary to the receipt or expenditure of any such
money, and his right in any other respect to control the administration of the trust,
shall at all times while the trustee order remains in force be subject to the discretion
of the trustee and to the order of the Court.
1208 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

512 Enforcement of trusts

The Court shall have jurisdiction to enforce, by injunction or otherwise, as
against any trustee under this Part, the obligations of his trust, and to hear and
determine as against any such trustee any pecuniary claim arising out of a breach
of trust.

513 Co-trustees must act jointly

When 2 or more trustees hold office under any trustee order in respect of
the same property, those trustees must act jointly in the exercise of the trust, and
no such powers shall be exercisable by less than the full number of trustees so
appointed, notwithstanding the existence of any vacancy in that number.

514 Remuneration of trustees

Any such trustee may be allowed out of the revenues or proceeds of the
trust property, by way of remuneration for his services in administering that
property, such reasonable sums as the Court orders, in addition to all costs, charges,
and expenses incurred by him in the execution of his trust.
PART 21
MARRIAGE

515 Prohibited degrees of consanguinity or affinity

(1) A marriage forbidden by the following Schedule is void—

Niue Act 1966 1209

SCHEDULE

Forbidden Marriages

1 A man may not marry his— 2 (1) Grandmother

(2) Grandfather ’s wife (3) Wife’s grandmother (4) Father ’s sister

(6) Mother ’s sister

(6) Mother

(7) Stepmother

(8) Wife’s mother

(9) Daughter

(10) Wife’s daughter

(11) Son’s wife

(12) Sister

(13) Son’s daughter

(14) Daughter ’s daughter

(15) Son’s son’s wife

(16) Daughter ’s son’s wife

(17) Wife’s son’s daughter

(18) Wife’s daughter ’s daughter

(19) Brother ’s daughter

(20) Sister ’s daughter

A woman may not marry her—

3 This Schedule shall apply whether the relationship is by whole blood or by the half blood.

4 In this Schedule, “wife” includes a former wife, whether she is alive or deceased, and

whether her marriage was terminated by death or divorce or otherwise; and “husband” has a

corresponding meaning.

(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1), any persons who are not within the degrees of consanguinity but are within the degrees of affinity so prohibited may apply to the Court for its consent to their marriage, and the Court may make an order dispensing with that prohibition so far as it relates to the parties to the application, and, if such an order is made, that prohibition shall cease to apply to the parties.

516 Marriages to take place before Marriage Officer

(1) Every marriage shall take place in the presence of a Marriage Officer
and of at least 2 other witnesses.
(2) In this section, “Marriage Officer” means any Judge or Commissioner
of the High Court, the Registrar of the High Court, or any person appointed as a
Marriage Officer under subsection (3).
(3) The Cabinet may appoint any minister of religion, or person whom it
believes to be a fit and proper person, as a Marriage Officer.
(4) A marriage celebrated other than in accordance with this section is void.

517–518 [Repealed by 2004/270]

519 Offence

If any person acts as a Marriage Officer in Niue without being qualified by
office or appointment so to act, he is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
3 years.
1210 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

520 Notice of marriage

(1) A Marriage Officer shall not solemnise or record any marriage, unless
notice in writing of the intention of the parties to enter into the marriage has been
given to the Marriage Officer by one of the parties at least 2 clear days before the
day of the marriage.
(2) On receipt of that notice, the Marriage Officer shall publish it in such
manner as he thinks sufficient to give due publicity to the intended marriage.
(3) On every such notice, there shall be payable by the person giving it
such fee (if any) as may be prescribed by regulations, and all such fees shall be
payable into the Niue Government Account.
(4) No marriage shall be invalidated by any breach of the requirements of
this section.

521 Mode of solemnisation

Every marriage shall, subject to this Part, be solemnised in such manner as
the Marriage Officer thinks fit.

522 Record of marriage

Every marriage shall, at the time of the solemnisation, be recorded in writing
by the Marriage Officer in the form and with the several particulars prescribed by
regulations under this Act, but no marriage shall be invalidated by any error or
defect in that form or in the particulars so required to be recorded.

523 Signature of record

The aforesaid record of every marriage shall be signed by the parties, and
by 2 witnesses, and by the Marriage Officer, all being present at the same time,
and when the record has been so signed the marriage shall be deemed to be fully
solemnised and shall take effect.

524 Transmission of record

The record of every marriage shall be forthwith delivered by the Marriage
Officer to the Registrar of the Court, and shall be preserved by the Registrar in the
same manner as if it was a record of the High Court.

525 Minimum age of marriage

A Marriage Officer shall not solemnise or record any marriage, unless the
husband is at least 18 years of age and the wife is at least 15 years of age, but no
marriage shall be invalidated by a breach of this section.

526 Marriage of minors

(1) A Marriage Officer shall not solemnise or record the marriage of any
man under the age of 21 years or of any woman under the age of 19 years without
the consent of one of the parents of the man or woman, if either of those parents is
alive and resident in Niue.
(2) A Judge of the Court may in any case, if he thinks fit so to do, grant
exemption from the requirements of this section.
(3) No marriage shall be invalidated by any breach of this section.

527 Offence by Marriage Officer

If any Marriage Officer commits any breach of the provisions of this Part,
or signs any record of a marriage containing any statement known by him to be
false, he is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

Niue Act 1966 1211

528 Signature of false record by party or witness

Every party or witness to a marriage who signs a record of it containing
any statement known by him or her to be false is liable to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 6 months or to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

529 Misrepresentation as to facts to procure marriage

Every person who, by any wilful misrepresentation made to a Marriage
Officer, procures or attempts to procure the solemnisation by that officer of any
marriage is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year.

530 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 22
DIVORCE

531 Nullity of marriage

The Court shall in proceedings for nullity of marriage have and exercise in
Niue the same jurisdiction as is possessed for the time being by the courts in New
Zealand.

532 [Repealed by 2004/270]

533 Domicile of a married woman

The domicile of a married woman shall be determined as if she were an
adult and single.

534 Grounds of divorce and jurisdiction of High Court

(1) Subject to subsection (2), any married person (the petitioner) may take
proceedings in the High Court for the dissolution of his or her marriage with the
other party to the marriage (hereinafter called the respondent) on any ground
specified in subsection (3).
(2) No proceedings for divorce may be taken in the High Court unless—
(a) The petitioner or the respondent is at the commencement of the
proceedings domiciled in Niue; and
(b) Where the ground alleged in the petition is one of those specified
in subsection (3) (l)(m) and (n), has been domiciled or resident in
Niue for 2 years at least immediately preceding the filing of the
petition.
(3) A petition for divorce may be presented to the High Court on one or
more of the following grounds, and on no other ground –
(a) That the respondent has since the solemnisation of the marriage
been guilty of adultery;
(b) That the respondent, being the wife of the petitioner, has since the
solemnisation of the marriage and without the consent of the
petitioner been artificially inseminated with the semen of some man
other than the petitioner;
(c) That the respondent without just cause has wilfully deserted the
petitioner and without just cause has left the petitioner continuously
so deserted for 3 years or more;
1212 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(d) That the respondent—
(i) Being the petitioner ’s husband, has for 3 years or more been
an habitual drunkard or drug addict, and has either habitually
left his wife without means of support or habitually been guilty
of cruelty towards her; or
(ii) Being the petitioner ’s wife, has for a like period been an habitual
drunkard or drug addict, and has either habitually neglected
her domestic duties and rendered herself unfit to discharge
them or habitually been guilty of cruelty towards him;
(e) That the respondent has since the solemnisation of the marriage
been convicted of attempting to commit the murder of the petitioner
or any child (of any age) of the petitioner or respondent, or has
been convicted of any offence under section 151 against the
petitioner or any such child;
(f) That the respondent has since the solemnisation of the marriage
been convicted of incest, attempted rape or assault with intent to
commit rape against any child (of any age) of the petitioner or
respondent, or of sexual intercourse or attempted sexual intercourse
with any such child under 15 years of age;
(g) That the respondent, being the husband of the petitioner, has
committed rape or buggery since the solemnisation of the marriage;
(h) That the respondent has since the solemnisation of the marriage
been convicted of murder;
(i) That the respondent is a person of unsound mind and is unlikely to
recover, and has been a patient for a period or periods of not less in
the aggregate than 7 years within the period of 10 years immediately
preceding the filing of the petition;
(j) That the respondent is a person of unsound mind and is unlikely to
recover, and has been continuously a person of unsound mind for
a period of 7 years immediately preceding the filing of the petition,
and has been a patient during the final 3 years of the said period of
7 years;
(k) That the respondent is a person of unsound mind and is unlikely to
recover, and has been a patient for a period of 5 years immediately
preceding the filing of the petition;
(l) That the petitioner and respondent are parties to an agreement for
separation, whether made by deed or other writing or orally, and
that the agreement is in full force and has been in full force for not
less than 3 years;
(m) That—
(i) the petitioner and respondent are parties to a decree, order, or
judgment made in Niue or in any country if that decree, order,
or judgment has in that country the effect that the parties are
not bound to live together; and
(ii) that decree of separation, separation order, or other decree,
order, or judgment is in full force and has been in full force for
not less than 3 years;
(n) That the petitioner and respondent are living apart and are unlikely
to be reconciled, and have been living apart for not less than 7 years.

Niue Act 1966 1213

535 Grounds of refusal of divorce

If the Court is of opinion—
(a) That, in the case of a petition based on a matrimonial wrong, the
petitioner ’s own habits or conduct induced or contributed to the
wrong complained of so as to disentitle the petitioner to a divorce
or the petitioner has condoned the wrong complained of; or
(b) That, in the case of the adultery of the respondent, the petitioner
has been in any manner accessory to or has connived at the
adultery—
the Court shall dismiss the suit; but, subject to section 536, in all other cases, if the
Court is satisfied that the case of the petitioner has been established, the Court
shall pronounce a decree of divorce.

536 Discretion to refuse decree in certain cases

(1) (a) Where a petition for divorce is presented on any of the grounds
specified in section 534 (3) (l) (m) and (n), and the petitioner has
proved his or her case, the Court shall have a discretion whether or
not to grant a decree of divorce.
(b) The Court shall not, in the exercise of that discretion, refuse to grant
a decree by reason only of the adultery of either party after their
separation.
(2) The Court may dismiss any petition for divorce if there has been
collusion between the petitioner and the respondent with intent to cause a
perversion of justice.

537 Co-respondent as a party

In any proceedings in the Court for divorce on the ground of adultery, the
Court may make the person with whom the respondent is alleged to have
committed adultery a co-respondent in the proceedings.

538 [Repealed by 2004/270]

539 Agreement no bar to divorce

No covenant or agreement between the parties to proceedings for divorce
shall operate as a bar to the institution or prosecution of the proceedings.

540 No appeal to Court of Appeal

No appeal shall lie to the Court of Appeal from any decree of the Court for
divorce.

541–542 [Repealed by 2004/270]

543 Order for maintenance of divorced wife

(1) When a decree of divorce is made by the Court, the Court may, in and
by the decree, order the husband to pay towards the future maintenance of his
wife (whether petitioner or respondent), so long as she remains unmarried, a
reasonable sum at such times and in such manner as the Court thinks fit.
(2) Every such order shall be deemed to be a maintenance order under
Part 23, and all the provisions of that Part shall, so far as applicable, apply to it
accordingly.
(3) In addition to or instead of making an order under subsection (1), the
Court may, when making any such decree, order the husband to pay to the wife
such capital sum as the Court thinks fit.
1214 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

544 Order as to custody of children

The Court may in and by any decree of divorce or of nullity, or at any time
and from time to time thereafter, make such order as it thinks fit as to the custody
of the children of the marriage.

545 Molestation of divorced wife by her husband

If, at any time after a decree of divorce or of dissolution of a voidable
marriage has been pronounced at the suit of the wife, her former husband—
(a) Commits any trespass by entering or remaining upon or in any
land, house, or building which is in her occupation or in which she
dwells or is present; or
(b) Attempts or threatens to commit any such trespass; or
(c) Molests her by watching or besetting her dwellinghouse or place
or business, employment, or residence, or by following or waylaying
her in any road or other public place—
he is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not
exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

546 [Repealed by 2004/270]

547 Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 23
MAINTENANCE AND AFFILIATION
“adequate maintenance” means maintenance reasonably sufficient for the necessities of the person to be maintained, irrespective of the means or ability of the person who is bound to afford such maintenance;
“child” means a person under the age of 16 years;
“defendant” means any person against whom a maintenance order or
affiliation order is or has been made under this Part or is applied for
under this Part;
“destitute person” means any person unable, whether permanently or
temporarily, to support himself by his own means or labour;
“maintenance” includes lodging, feeding, clothing, teaching, training,
attendance, and medical and surgical relief;
“maintenance order” means an order under this Part for the payment of
money for or in respect of the past or future maintenance of any person.

548 [Repealed by 2004/270]

549 Applications

Any application to the Court for or in relation to a maintenance order or an
affiliation order may, except where otherwise expressly provided, be made either
by the person in whose favour the order is to be or has been made or by any other
person.

550 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Niue Act 1966 1215

551 Affiliation orders

(1) On application made to the Court by or by the authority of a woman
who is the mother of a child or who is with child, the Court may, if it is satisfied
that the defendant (not being her husband) is the father of that child, make an
order (herein called an affiliation order) adjudging the defendant to be the father
of that child accordingly.
(2) No affiliation order shall be so made unless the application is made
before or within 6 years after the birth of the child, unless the defendant has
contributed to or made provision for the maintenance of the child, or has since the
birth of the child cohabited with the mother as man and wife, in which case the
application may be made at any time after the expiration of the said period of 6
years, if within 2 years immediately preceding the application the defendant has
contributed to or provided for the maintenance of the child or has so cohabited
with its mother.
(3) If at any time the defendant has been absent from Niue, the period of
his absence shall not be counted in computing the respective periods of 6 years or
2 years.
(4) No such application shall be made unless the child is under 16 years of
age at the time of the application.

552 Evidence

(1) The evidence of the mother of the child or of any woman who is with
child as aforesaid shall not be necessary for the making of an affiliation order.
(2) No person shall be adjudged to be the father of a child upon the evidence
of the mother or of a woman who is with child as aforesaid, unless her evidence is
corroborated in some material particular to the satisfaction of the Court.

553 Maintenance order in favour of illegitimate child

When an affiliation order has been made by the Court against any person
as the father of a child, whether already born or not, the Court may, at the same
time or at any time thereafter, make a maintenance order in favour of the child
against the person so adjudged to be the father of the child.

554 Maintenance order against father in favour of child

(1) The Court may make a maintenance order against the father of any
child (not being an illegitimate child) in favour of that child if the Court is satisfied
that the father has failed or intends to fail to provide that child with adequate
maintenance.
(2) When the father and child are living apart from each other, and the
Court is satisfied that there is reasonable cause for the child continuing so to live
apart from the father, the father shall not be deemed to have made provision for
the adequate maintenance of the child merely by reason of the fact that he is ready
and willing to support the child if and so long as the child lives with him.

555 Maintenance order against mother in favour of child

(1) The High Court may make a maintenance order in favour of a child
against the mother of that child, if it is satisfied that the mother is of sufficient
ability in that behalf and has failed or intends to fail to make provision for the
adequate maintenance of the child.
(2) When the mother and child are living apart from each other, and the
Court is satisfied that there is reasonable cause for the child continuing so to live
apart from the mother, the mother shall not be deemed to have made provision
1216 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
for the adequate maintenance of the child merely by reason of the fact that she is ready and willing to support the child if and so long as the child lives with her.

556 Maintenance order against husband

(1) The Court may make a maintenance order against a husband in favour
of his wife, if it is satisfied that the husband has failed or intends to fail to provide
his wife with adequate maintenance.
(2) Unless the Court is satisfied that the wife is a destitute person, no
maintenance order shall be made against the husband if it is proved that he is not
of sufficient ability to contribute to her maintenance.
(3) When the husband and wife are living apart from one another and the
wife has, in the opinion of the Court, reasonable cause for refusing or failing to
live with her husband, the husband shall not be deemed to have provided her
with adequate maintenance merely by reason of the fact that he is ready and willing
to support her if and so long as she lives with him.

557 Maintenance order against wife

(1) The Court may make a maintenance order against a married woman in
favour of her husband, if it is satisfied that the husband is a destitute person and
that his wife is of sufficient ability to contribute to his maintenance.
(2) No such order shall be made if the Court is satisfied that there is
reasonable cause for the failure of the wife to contribute to the maintenance of her
husband.

558 Maintenance order against any person in favour of father or mother

The Court may make a maintenance order against any person in favour of
the father or mother of that person, if it is satisfied that the father or mother, is a
destitute person and that the defendant is of sufficient ability to contribute to the
maintenance of that destitute person.

559 Disobedience to maintenance order

Every person who disobeys a maintenance order commits an offence and
is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit and imprisonment for
a term not exceeding 6 months.

560 Maintenance money a debt

All money due under a maintenance order shall constitute a debt due by
the defendant to the person to whom the money is payable under the terms of the
order.

561 Order in favour of non-residents

A maintenance order may be made in favour of any person otherwise
entitled to it although not present or resident in Niue.

562 Order against non-residents

A maintenance or affiliation order may be made against any defendant
otherwise liable although not present or resident in Niue.

563 Orders in absentia

If the Court is satisfied that a defendant is absent from Niue, or that his
residence is unknown, or that he cannot be found, the Court may hear and
determine the application ex parte and make a maintenance order or affiliation
order accordingly.

Niue Act 1966 1217

564 Repeated applications

The dismissal of an application for a maintenance order or affiliation order
shall not, unless the Court so orders, be a bar to the making of a further application
in the same matter against the same defendant.

565 Payments not to be made in advance

(1) No money payable under a maintenance order shall, without the
precedent consent of a Judge of the High Court, be paid more than one year in
advance of the due date of it.
(2) If any money is paid in breach of this section, it shall not be taken into
account in any proceedings for the enforcement of the maintenance order or for
the punishment of any disobedience to it; but no money so paid in breach of this
section shall be recoverable by the person by whom it was paid.

566 Cancellation, variation, and suspension of orders

(1) The High Court may at any time make an order cancelling an affiliation
order, or cancelling, varying, or suspending any maintenance order or substituting
a new maintenance order, on the grounds—
(a) That the order was obtained by fraud or perjury; or
(b) That since the making of the order new and material and evidence
has been discovered; or
(c) That since the making of the order the circumstances have so
changed that the order ought to be so cancelled, varied, or
suspended, or that a new order ought to be substituted for it.
(2) The power hereby conferred to cancel or vary an order shall include
the power to remit wholly or in part any arrears due under the order, and any
such arrears may be remitted either on the grounds hereinbefore in this section
mentioned or, if the Court thinks fit, on the ground that the defendant is not of
sufficient ability to pay them.

567 Payment of maintenance money

Any maintenance order may direct the money payable under it to be paid
either to the person in whose favour the order is made or to any other person on
behalf of that person.

568 Security for obedience to maintenance orders

(1) Whenever a maintenance order is made, the High Court may, by the
same order or by order made at any later time, direct the defendant to give security
for his obedience to the maintenance order.
(2) Every such security shall, as the Court determines, be either the payment
into Court of such sum of money, not exceeding 4 penalty units, as the Court
directs, or the giving of a bond to Her Majesty with one or 2 sureties to be approved
by the Court in a sum not exceeding 4 penalty units, conditioned for due obedience
to the maintenance order.
(3) When such security has been required, the Court may commit the
defendant to prison until the order requiring security has been complied with,
but no person shall be so detained in custody for a longer period than 6 months.
(4) All money so paid into Court or recovered by suit or otherwise under
any such bond shall be available, under the direction of the Court, for the
satisfaction of all claims under the maintenance order.
(5) The Court may, on being satisfied that the security is no loner required,
order any amount so paid into Court to be repaid to the defendant, or cancel any
bond so given.
1218 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

569 Operation of agreements

No agreement shall be effective so as to take away or restrict any liability
imposed on any person by this Act to contribute to the maintenance of any other
person, or affect the operation of any maintenance order or the right of the High
Court to make any such order.

570 Purport and duration of maintenance orders

(1) Every maintenance order shall be an order for the periodical payment,
at such times and in such manner as the Court thinks fit, of such sum of money as
the Court thinks reasonable.
(2) The intervals between the successive payments shall not exceed 28 days.
(3) When any such order is made in respect of the maintenance of a child,
the order shall cease to be in force so soon as that child attains the age of 16 years.

571 Order for past maintenance

Any maintenance order may require the defendant, in addition to making
such periodical payments as aforesaid, to pay such sum as the Court thinks
reasonable, not exceeding 1 penalty unit, on account of the past maintenance,
previous to the making of the order, of the person in respect of whose maintenance
the order is made.

Offences

572 Leaving Niue while maintenance money in arrear

(1) Every person against whom a maintenance order has been made is
liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, if, while any money
payable under the order is in arrear and unpaid, he leaves or attempts to leave
Niue without the permission in writing of a Judge of the High Court.
(2) In any prosecution under this section the burden of proving that the
permission of a Judge was so given shall be upon the accused.

573 Leaving Niue after affiliation order and before birth of child

(1) Every person against whom an affiliation order is made before the birth
of the child is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, if he leaves
or attempts to leave Niue without the permission in writing of a Judge of the
Court at any time within 12 months after the making of the order.
(2) In any prosecution under this section the burden of proving that the
permission of a Judge was so given shall be upon the accused.

574 Leaving Niue with intent to disobey maintenance order

Every person against whom a maintenance order has been made is liable
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, if he at any time after it leaves
or attempts to leave Niue with intent to make default in obeying that order.

575 Leaving Niue while failing to maintain wife

(1) Every person is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years,
if he without reasonable cause fails to provide his wife with adequate maintenance
and at any time while failing so to do leaves or attempts to leave Niue without the
permission in writing of a Judge of the High Court.
(2) In any prosecution under this section the burden of proving that the
permission of a Judge was so obtained shall be upon the accused.

Niue Act 1966 1219

576 Leaving Niue while failing to maintain child

(1) Every person who is the father of a child is liable to imprisonment for a
term not exceeding 2 years, if he without reasonable cause fails to provide that
child with adequate maintenance and at any time while failing so to do leaves or
attempts to leave Niue without the permission in writing of a Judge of the High
Court.
(2) In any prosecution under this section the burden of proving that the permission of a Judge was so given shall be upon the accused.

577 Leaving Niue with intent to desert wife or child

Every person who is the husband of any woman or the father of any child
is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, if he leaves or attempts
to leave Niue with the intention of failing without reasonable cause to make
adequate provision for the maintenance of that wife or child during his absence.

578 [Repealed by 2004/270]

579 Evidence of intent

In any prosecution for an offence against this Part, the fact that the defendant
has at any time within 3 years after leaving Niue habitually made default in obeying
an order of maintenance or in providing his wife or child with adequate
maintenance shall be sufficient evidence, unless the contrary is proved, that the
defendant left Niue with intent so to make default.

580-592 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 24

593–599 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 25
PART 26
PERSONS OF UNSOUND MIND

Orders of Medical Custody

600 Application by Medical Officer to Court

Any Medical Officer may make application to the Court for an order
committing any person to medical custody under this Part on the ground that
that person is of unsound mind.

601 Medical certificates as to persons of unsound mind

No such order shall be made except on examination of the person alleged
to be of unsound mind, and upon production to the Court of a certificate by the
Director of Health or by 2 Medical Officers that the person in respect of whom the
order is to be made is of unsound mind and that his detention in medical custody
is necessary in his own interests or for the safety of other persons.

602 Order of medical custody

If the Court is satisfied on the examination of the person so alleged to be of
unsound mind, and on hearing such further evidence (if any) as the Court thinks
necessary, that he is of unsound mind and that his detention in medical custody is
necessary in his own interests or for the safety of other persons, the Court may
make an order (hereinafter called an order of medical custody) committing him to
medical custody for such period as the Court thinks fit, not exceeding 6 months.
1220 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

603 Renewal of order

Any such order may, whether before or after the expiry of it, be renewed
for such further period, not exceeding 6 months, as the Court on a further
application and certificate as aforesaid thinks fit.

604 Cancellation of order

Any such order may be at any time cancelled by the Court.

605 [Repealed by 2004/270]

606 Arrest and detention of persons committed to medical custody

Any person against whom an order of medical custody has been so made
may thereupon be arrested by any constable or Medical Officer, and shall, while
the order remains in force, be detained at such hospitals or other places in Niue,
and in the custody of such Medical Officer, as may be determined in that behalf
by the Director of Health, either generally or in respect of any particular case or
class of cases.

607 [Repealed by 2004/270]

608 Removal from Niue to New Zealand

When an order of medical custody has been so made against any person,
the High Court may, at the same time or at any time after it while the order remains
in force, issue under the seal of the Court a warrant for the removal of that person
from Niue to New Zealand.

609 Conditions of removal

No such warrant shall be issued unless the Court is satisfied, on the
certificate by the Director of Health or by 2 Medical Officers, and on the examination
of the person alleged to be of unsound mind, that his removal from Niue to New
Zealand is necessary in his own interests or for the safety of other persons.

610 Method of removal

On the issue of any such warrant for the removal of any person to New
Zealand, he may be taken to New Zealand in the custody of any person appointed
in that behalf by a Medical Officer in any ship belonging to Her Majesty or in any
Commonwealth ship or in any aircraft which is approved by the Director of Health
or 2 Medical officers as suitable for the purpose.

611 Admission to hospital of persons removed to New Zealand

(1) Where any person in respect of whom a warrant for removal to New
Zealand is made under section 608 arrives in New Zealand under the warrant,
then, on the delivery to the Superintendent of a hospital within the meaning of
the Mental Health Act 1969 of copies, under the seal of the High Court, of that
warrant, the order of medical custody made in respect of that person under section
602, the application to the Court for the last-mentioned order, and the certificate
produced to the Court under section 601 in respect of that application, the
Superintendent shall receive that person and may detain him in the hospital under
this section.
(2) Where any person is received into a hospital under this section, the
order and warrant made or issued in respect of him under sections 602 and 608
shall be sufficient authority for his detention in the hospital for a period of 7 days.

Niue Act 1966 1221

(3) At any time before the expiration of that period, the Superintendent of the hospital may apply for a reception order under the Mental Health Act 1969 in respect of the person so received into the hospital; and the fact that such an application has been made shall be sufficient authority for the Superintendent to detain that person until the application is finally determined.
[This section is not Niue law.]

612 [Repealed by 2004/270]

613 No committee of estate of person of unsound mind

The High Court may appoint a committee of the person or estate of a person
of unsound mind.

614 Warrant for arrest of persons of unsound mind

Any person against whom an application has been made for an order of
medical custody may be arrested by any constable or other person under a warrant
issued by a Judge or the Registrar of the High Court.

615 Arrest without warrant of persons of unsound mind

Any person believed on reasonable grounds to be of unsound mind and to
be dangerous to himself or others may be arrested without warrant by a constable,
and shall be forthwith brought before a Judge or the Registrar of the High Court,
who may make such order for his custody as is thought fit, pending the making
and determination of an application for an order of medical custody.

615A Commissioner and Justices may act for Judge

(1) Any power conferred by this Act on the Court to make an order under
sections 602, 603, 604 or 608 may be exercised by a Commissioner of the High
Court or any 2 Justices of the Peace if at the time when the power is exercised
there is not present in Niue a Judge who is able to exercise it.
(2) In any such order made by the Commissioner or 2 Justices of the Peace,
a statement that, or to the effect that, to the best of his or their knowledge and
belief, at the time of making of the order there is not present in Niue a Judge who
is able to make it shall be conclusive proof of the jurisdiction of the Commissioner
or Justices as the case may be so far as the requirements of this section are in
question.
(3) Any proceedings commenced before a Commissioner or 2 Justices of
the Peace under this section may be continued and completed before a Judge.
(4) No Commissioner or Justice shall exercise any power under this section
in any matter in which he has signed an application for a reception order or a
medical certificate.

Persons of Unsound Mind Charged with Offences

616 Insane persons not to be tried for offences

If any person on being charged with an offence before the Court is found to
be of unsound mind so that he cannot understand the nature of the proceedings,
he shall not be tried, but the Court shall order him to be detained in prison or in
some other place of security.
1222 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

617 Accused persons acquitted on ground of insanity

(1) If any person on his trial for an offence before the Court is found to
have been insane at the time of the commission of the offence, he shall be found
not guilty on the ground of insanity, and the Court shall order him to be detained
in prison or in some other place of security.
(2) A person so detained may apply to the High Court for discharge at any
time but an application may not be made at more frequent intervals than 6 months.

618 Discharge

(1) A person who is detained under section 616 shall not be so detained for
a period of more than one month, and may at any time be discharged by order of
the Court.
(2) Such a person may further be brought before the Court and either tried
for the offence in respect of which he or she is detained or be again detained
under section 616.

619 Orders of medical custody

When any person is so detained, whether in the case of a charge of murder
or manslaughter or otherwise, the Court shall have the same jurisdiction to make
an order of medical custody or to issue a warrant for removal to New Zealand as
in the case of any other person of unsound mind.

620 The defence of insanity in criminal prosecutions

(1) No person charged with any offence shall be acquitted on the ground
of insanity, unless the offence was committed by him while labouring under natural
imbecility or disease of the mind to such an extent as to render him incapable of
understanding the nature or quality of the act done by him or of knowing that the
act was wrong.
(2) A person labouring under specific delusions but in other respects sane
shall not be acquitted on the ground of insanity, unless the delusions caused him
to believe in the existence of some state of things which, if it existed, would justify
or excuse his act.
(3) Every one shall be presumed to be and to have been sane unless the
contrary is proved.

621–633 [Repealed 18/2/1975]

PART 27

634–644 [Repealed by 1968/68]

PART 28

645 Interpretation

PART 29
NIUEAN ANTIQUITIES
In this Part, “Niuean antiquities” includes Niuean relics, articles manufactured with ancient Niuean tools and according to Niuean methods and all other articles or things of historical or scientific value or interest and relating to Niue; but does not include any botanical or mineral collections or specimens.

646 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Niue Act 1966 1223

647 Niuean antiquities to be offered for sale before exportation

It shall not be lawful to remove from Niue any Niuean antiquities without
first offering them for sale to the Cabinet on behalf of Her Majesty for the benefit
of the people of Niue.

648 Power to detain Niuean antiquities attempted to be exported

It shall be the duty of all constables and officers of Customs to seize and
detain any Niuean antiquities attempted to be removed from Niue contrary to
this Part.

649 Exporting Niuean antiquities without permission

(1) Every person who, without the express permission in writing of the
Cabinet, exports from Niue any Niuean antiquities is liable to a fine not exceeding
2 penalty units.
(2) Notice of the intention to export any Niuean antiquities shall be given
by the exporter to the Revenue Manager or other proper officer of Customs at
least 24 hours before shipment.
(3) (a) Any Niuean antiquities entered for export contrary to this Part shall
be deemed to be forfeited, and shall vest in Her Majesty for the
benefit of the people of Niue.
(b) The Cabinet may, after inquiry, cancel the forfeiture if the Cabinet
thinks fit.

650 Power to remove antiquities in certain cases

Nothing in this Part shall be deemed to prevent any person who has offered
any Niuean antiquities for sale as provided by section 647 from removing those
Niuean antiquities from Niue, if he has previously obtained the permission in
writing of Cabinet.

651 Right to copy of antiquities intended to be exported

(1) On any application for permission to export any Niuean antiquities,
Cabinet may, make it a condition of the granting of the application that the owner
allows them to be copied, by photography, cast, or otherwise, in such manner and
by such person as Cabinet directs.
(2) Every such copy shall be the property of Her Majesty for the benefit of
the people of Niue.

652 Cabinet to decide what articles come under this Part

In case any dispute arises as to whether any article or thing comes within
the scope of this Part, that dispute shall be determined by the Cabinet, whose
decision shall be final.

653 [Repealed by 1971/71]

1224 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

654–655A [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 30
CUSTOMS

656 Goods may be imported from New Zealand or Cook Islands free of duty (1) All goods imported into Niue from New Zealand or the Cook Islands, whether the produce or manufacture of New Zealand or the Cook Islands or not,

shall be admitted into Niue free of duty.
(2) Nothing in this section shall apply to—
(a) Goods in respect of which on their exportation from New Zealand
or the Cook Islands any claim for drawback of duty has been made
and allowed;
(b) Goods which by reason of warehousing or for any other reason
have been exported from New Zealand or the Cook Islands without
payment of duty on their importation into New Zealand or the Cook
Islands;
(c) Goods produced in a manufacturing warehouse in New Zealand
or the Cook Islands, unless they have been entered in New Zealand
or the Cook Islands for home consumption and the duty (if any)
paid on it;
(d) Goods subject to any excise duty in New Zealand under the
Customs Acts (as defined in section 3 of the Customs Act 1966) or
in the Cook Islands under the law in force in the Cook Islands, unless
such duty has been paid on it as if they had not been exported;
(e) Goods on which a rate of duty has been paid in New Zealand or
the Cook Islands lower than that to which the goods are subject in
Niue at the time of their importation into Niue.

657 [Repealed by 4/76/1982]

658 [Repealed by 2004/270]

659–670 [Repealed by 2004/270]

671 [Repealed by 1967/67]

PART 31
PART 32
THE LAWS OF NIUE: GENERAL PROVISIONS

Application of the Laws of New Zealand

672–677 [Repealed by 2004/269]

678 Criminal procedure in Niue

In every enactment in force in Niue, every reference to the trial of offences
by way of indictment or by way of summary proceedings shall, in the application
of that enactment to Niue, be construed as a reference to the trial of such offences
by the High Court in the ordinary course of its criminal jurisdiction and procedure.

679–684A [Repealed by 2004/270]

685 [Repealed by 1975/5]

Niue Act 1966 1225

686–689 [Repealed by 2004/270]

689A Misuse of Drugs Act in force in Niue

(1) Subject to subsection (2) and to the provisions of this Act, the Misuse of
Drugs Act 1975 (so far as it is applicable) shall extend to and be in force in Niue.
(2) In the application of the Misuse of Drugs Act 1975 to Niue, unless the
context otherwise requires—
(a) Every reference in that Act to New Zealand shall be read as a
reference to Niue;
(b) Every reference in section 35 of that Act to an extradition treaty for
the time being in force between New Zealand and any foreign
country which is a party to the Single Convention on Narcotic Drugs
1961, as amended by the Protocol amending that Convention done
at Geneva on 25 March 1972, or to the Convention on Psychotropic
Substances 1971, shall be read as a reference to an extradition treaty
for the time being in force between New Zealand and any such
foreign country which extends to Niue;
(c) Every reference to that Act to the Court, or to a Judge, or to a
Magistrate or Justice, shall be read as a reference to the High Court
of Niue or a Judge of that Court or a Commissioner of that Court;
(d) Every reference in that Act to the Minister of Health shall be read
as a reference to the Minister in charge of Health in Niue acting
with the concurrence of the Chief Medical Officer of Niue;
(e) Every reference in that Act to the Medical Officer of Health shall be
read as a reference to the Chief Medical Officer of Niue;
(f) Every reference in that Act to a constable or a member of the Police
shall be read as a reference to an officer of police of the Niue Public
Service;
(g) The references in section 6 of that Act to section 44 (2) of the Criminal
Justice Act 1954 shall be read as references to section 240 of the
Niue Act 1966;
(h) The references in section 18 of that Act to section 198 of the Summary
Proceedings Act 1957 shall be read as references to section 284 of
the Niue Act 1966:

690–705 [Repealed by 2004/270]

706 Limitation of actions

(1) The law of Niue as to prescription and the limitation of actions shall be
the same as that which is in force for the time being in New Zealand.
(2) For the purposes of the law as to prescription and the limitation of
actions, New Zealand shall in Niue be deemed to be parts beyond the seas, and
Niue shall in New Zealand be deemed to be parts beyond the seas.
(3) No right, title, estate, or interest in Niuean land shall be acquired or
lost by prescription or limitation.

Miscellaneous Rules of Law

707 Legal status of married women

(1) Save where otherwise provided by this Act, the legal capacity of a
1226 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
married woman, whether contractual, proprietary, testamentary, or of any other kind whatsoever, shall be the same as that of an unmarried woman.
(2) Save in respect of intestate succession, marriage shall not confer on either party any rights to or in respect of the property of the other.
(3) The rule of the common law that for certain purposes a husband and wife are deemed to be one person only is hereby abolished for all purposes, including the law of domicile.
(4) A husband shall not be responsible, as such, for torts committed by his
wife.
(5) Nothing in this section shall affect the validity or operation of a restraint
on anticipation.

708 Legitimacy

(1) Every person, whether born before or after 1 January 1967, and whether
born in Niue or not, and whether or not his parents or either of them were domiciled
in Niue at the time of his birth, shall for all the purposes of the law of Niue be
deemed to be the legitimate child of each of his parents, and all other relationships
in respect of that person shall be deemed to be traced through lawful wedlock
accordingly.
(2) The provisions of this section—
(a) In so far as it affects wills, shall have effect only in relation to the
wills of testators who die after 1 January 1967; and
(b) In so far as it affects instruments other than wills, shall have effect
only in relation to instruments executed after 1 January 1967.
(3) All wills of testators who have died before 1 January 1967, and all other
instruments executed before 1 January 1967, shall be governed by the enactments
and rules of law which would have applied to them if this Act had not been passed.
(4) The estates of all persons who have died intestate as to the whole or
any part of it before 1 January 1967 shall be distributed under the enactments
which would have applied to them if this Act had not been passed.
(5) No action shall lie against any executor or administrator or trustee of
the estate of any person who dies after 1 January 1967 or the trustee under any
instrument executed after 1 January 1967 by any person whose relationship to the
deceased or to any other person or, as the case may be, to the settlor or to any
other person is in any degree traced otherwise than through lawful wedlock, by
reason of the executor or administrator or trustee having made any distribution
of the estate or trust disregarding the claims of the person so related where at the
time of making the distribution the executor, administrator, or trustee had no notice
of the relationship of that person to the deceased or the settlor or any other person.

709 Joint liability

A judgment against one or more of several persons jointly or jointly and
severally liable shall not operate as a bar or defence to an action or other proceeding
against any of those persons against whom judgment has not been recovered,
except to the extent to which the judgment has been satisfied, any rule of law
notwithstanding.

710 Contracts of guarantee

Niue Act 1966 1227

No special promise by any person to answer for the debt, default, or miscarriage of another person, being in writing and signed by the party to be charged with it or some other person lawfully authorised by him, shall be deemed invalid to support an action or other proceedings to charge the person by whom the promise was made by reason only that the consideration for the promise does not appear in writing or by necessary inference from a written document.

711–713 [Repealed by 2004/270]

714 Liability of owners of dogs

In any action for damages for the act of a dog in attacking a human being
or any animal, it shall be no defence that the defendant had no knowledge of the
dangerous or mischievous character of the dog.

715 Distress for rent abolished

(1) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any Act, or in any rule of
law or in any lease to the contrary, it shall not be lawful for any person to distrain
for rent.
(2) This section shall extend and apply to leases granted by the Crown.

716 Libel and slander

In any action in the Court for defamation (whether libel or slander), it shall
not be necessary to allege or prove special damage.

717-719 [Repealed by 2004/269]

720 Statutory declarations

(1) Any Judge of the Court, any Commissioner, the Registrar of the Court,
the Controller of Customs, or any law practitioner entitled to practice in the courts
of Niue may take and receive the declaration of any person, in the form in the
Schedule 2.
(2) If any person wilfully makes a declaration that is false in any material
particular, he is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years.

721 [Repealed by 2004/270]

722 Taxes on Niuean land

All taxes imposed by any Act, or other lawful authority upon Niuean land
or upon any person in respect of the ownership or occupation of Niuean land
shall constitute a charge upon that land.

723 [Repealed by 2004/270]

724 Warrants of arrest

(1) Except where other provision is made by law in that behalf, any warrant
for the arrest of any person in Niue may be directed either to any constable or
other person by name, or generally to the constables of Niue.
(2) When such a warrant is directed to constables generally, any such
constable may execute the warrant in like manner as if it was directed specially to
him by name.
(3) Any such warrant may be granted and executed on a Sunday, and either
1228 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
by day or night.
(4) Every such warrant shall name or otherwise describe the person against
whom it is issued.
(5) It shall not be necessary to make any such warrant returnable at any
particular time, but it may remain in full force until executed.

725 Trespass ab initio

No lawful entry, seizure, arrest, or other act shall by reason of any unlawful
act subsequent to it be deemed to have been a trespass ab initio.

726 [Repealed]

727 [Repealed by 2004/270]

727A Births and deaths

The Cabinet may make regulations to provide for the registration of births
and deaths and the due administration of it.

728–735 [Repealed by 2004/270]

736 Contributory negligence

Where a person suffers loss or damage as the result partly of personal fault
and partly of the fault of any other person, a claim in respect of that loss or damage
shall not be defeated by reason of the fault of the person suffering the loss or
damage, but the compensation recoverable shall be reduced to the extent the Court
thinks just and equitable having regard to the claimant’s share in the responsibility
for the loss or damage.

737 Protection of intellectual property

A copyright, design, patent, or trademark protected by New Zealand law
shall be accorded the same protection by the courts of Niue as that available in
New Zealand under the laws of New Zealand for the time being in force.
[See also Act 2006/280/section 12]

738 Aerodromes

(1) For the purposes of ensuring the safety of flight operations into, out of,
and in the vicinity of any aerodrome, Cabinet may, by notice published in the

Gazette

(a) Prohibit, either absolutely or beyond a height specified in the notice, the erection or placing or extension of any building, pole, mast, or other structure of any kind on the land described in the notice;
(b) Limit the height to which trees, shrubs, vegetation, or foliage may be permitted to grow on the land described in the notice;
(c) Limit and specify the purposes for which land described in the
notice may be used, and the species and varieties of trees, shrubs,
vegetation, or foliage which may be grown or permitted to grow
on any land described in the notice;
(2) Where any land, building, pole, mast, or other structure interferes in
any way with the use by aircraft of any aerodrome, Cabinet may, by notice in
writing served on the Leveki Mangafaoa and the occupier of the land and on all
other persons known to have any right or estate in it, require the removal or
lowering of the land or of the building, pole, mast, or other structure to the

Niue Act 1966 1229

satisfaction of the Cabinet within 2 months after service of the notice.
(3) Cabinet may, if there is a failure to comply with any notice served under
subsection (2) take any steps Cabinet considers necessary to ensure compliance
with the terms of the notice.
(4) Cabinet may take any steps the Cabinet considers necessary to remove,
top, or trim any tree, shrub, vegetation, or foliage on any land for the purpose of
ensuring the safety of flight operations into, out of, and in the vicinity of any
aerodrome. Before exercising the powers conferred by this subsection Cabinet
shall give not less than one month’s notice in writing to the j and to the occupier
of the land.
(5) Every person having any right or interest in any land injuriously
affected, or suffering any damage, from the exercise of any powers given by this
section shall be entitled to compensation, which shall be determined by the Court
in the same manner as is prescribed by section 13 of the Niue Amendment Act
(No2) 1968 in the case of land taken under that Act.
(6) In the case of any claim to compensation for restrictions placed upon
the use of land, the Court shall, in assessing compensation, take into account not
only the loss caused by the restrictions but also the cost of labour reasonably
incurred by any Leveki Mangafaoa or occupier in ensuring compliance with the
restrictions.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

[Repealed by 1974/43 (NZ)]

–––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 2

FORM OF DECLARATION

I,A.B. [Insert place of abode and occupation or description], solemnly and sincerely declare

that [Insert facts]. And I make this solemn declaration conscientiously believing the same

to be true, and by virtue of the Niue Act 1966.

Declared at in Niue this day of 20 before me ­

A.B.

C.D.

Judge of the High Court of Niue, or Commissioner of the High Court, Registrar of the High Court, member of Cabinet, Finance Secretary of Customs, justice of the Peace, Medical Officer of Niue, Solicitor of the Supreme Court of New Zealand, as the case may be.

1230 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1231

NIUE AMENDMENT ACT (No 2) 1968

1968/132 (NZ) – 1 November 1969

57 Registration of orders affecting title to land

1232 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Contempt of the Land Court

58 Contempt of Land Court defined

59 Penalty for contempt

60 Jurisdiction in contempt

61 Contempt in face of the Land Court

62 Arrest on warrant

63 Conviction by Land Court

64 Enforcement of fine

65 Discharge of persons in contempt

66 Jurisdiction in contempt may be exercised

at any time or place

PART 6

THE COURT OF APPEAL

67-74 [Repealed]

75 Appeals from Land Court

76 Appeals from provisional determinations

as to title to Niuean land

77 Successive appeals in respect of same

matter

78 Powers of Court of Appeal on appeal

79 Dismissal of appeal for non-prosecution

80 Variation deemed part of original order

81 Orders of Court of Appeal

82 Contempt

83 Court of Appeal may order surveys

86 Warrant declaring existing roads

87 Warrants declaring new roads

88 Warrants as to roads to be gazetted

89 Access to land

90 Closing of roads

PART 8

ADOPTION

91 Interpretation

92 Adoption by Niuean custom invalid

93 Adoption by Niuean custom before 1 April

1916 by parent dying before 5 December

1921

94 Validity of adoption registered before 1

April 1916

95 Court may make adoption orders

96 Prohibition of payments in consideration

of adoption

97 Restrictions on making adoption orders

98 Consents to adoptions

99 Effect of adoption order

100 Adoption order may be varied or

discharged

101 Adoption orders under Cook Islands

Amendment Act 1921

PART 9

PART 7

ROADS

84 Definition of “road”

85 Public rights over roads

102-103 [Spent]

104 [Repealed]

SCHEDULE

1 Short title

This is the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968, and shall be read together
with and deemed part of the Niue Act 1966 (the principal Act).

2 Interpretation

For the purposes of the principal Act (including this Act) –
“alienation”, in relation to Niuean land, means the making or grant of any
transfer, sale, gift, lease, licence, easement, profit, mortgage, charge,
encumbrance, trust, or other disposition, whether absolute or limited,
and whether legal or equitable; and includes a contract to make any
such alienation; and also includes the surrender or variation of a lease,
licence, easement, or profit and the variation of the terms of any other
alienation as hereinbefore defined;
“Church purposes” means the provision for the benefit of the adherents of
some Christian denomination of a site for a place of worship, or for a
pastor ’s house, or for a school conducted by the denomination, or for
houses for pupils or teachers of such a school, or for a plantation for
the support of pupils or teachers of such a school, or for any one or
more of such purposes;

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1233
“Crown land” means land in Niue vested in the Government, being land that is free from Niuean custom;
“customary title” means title under the customs and usages of Niue; “Land Court” means the Land Division of the High Court;
“Leveki Mangafaoa” means a trustee or guardian of a family having any right, title, estate, or interest in Niuean land;
“Niuean land” means land in Niue held by Niueans according to the customs and usages in Niue;
“public purpose” means all purposes for which money is appropriated by
the Assembly and all lawful purposes and functions of the Government
and includes naval, military, and air defence, education, public health,
fisheries, public buildings, wharves, jetties, harbours, prisons, water
supply, sites for villages, housing purposes, public recreation, land
development, and the burial of the dead.
PART 1
LAND TENURE

3 Classification of land in Niue

All land in Niue is Crown land or Niuean land.

4 [Repealed by 2004/270]

5 [Repealed 10/29/1977]

6 Administration and tenure of land

(1) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(2) The Registrar of the High Court shall proceed to register the title to all
land in accordance with this Act and any other relevant enactment.

7 [Repealed by 2004/270]

8 Grants of Crown land

PART 2
CROWN LAND
(1) Subject to any enactment, the Cabinet may, by warrant, grant in respect of Crown land any lease, licence, easement, or other limited estate, right, or interest, or may accept a surrender of any estate, right, or interest in such land.
(2) In the case of Crown land reserved or set apart for any public purpose,
no such grant shall be made except so far as consistent with that purpose.

9 Crown land may be declared Niuean land

(1) The Cabinet may, by warrant, declare that any Crown land which is
not subject to any lease or to any other right, title, estate, or interest vested in any
person shall be Niuean land, and may in the warrant indicate with what
particularity it thinks fit the Leveki Mangafaoa, the person, or the family or group
of Niueans by whom or on whose behalf it shall be held.
(2) The Land Court shall have jurisdiction to hear and determine any
dispute between Niueans affecting land which has become Niuean land under
subsection (1), and may vary or describe with further particularity the Leveki

Mangafaoa, the person, or the family or group of Niueans by whom or on whose

behalf the land or any part of it shall be held.
1234 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

10 Reserves of Crown land for public purposes

Any Crown land may, by warrant of the Cabinet, be set aside as a reserve
for any public purpose, and shall be reserved and used for that purpose accordingly,
but any such warrant may be at any time revoked.

11 Taking of land for public purposes

(1) The Cabinet may by warrant, take any land in Niue for any public
purpose specified in the warrant, and it shall thereupon become absolutely vested
in the Crown as from the date of the warrant, or from any later date specified
therein in that behalf, free from all estates, rights, and interests of any other person
therein, save so far as any such estates, rights, or interests are expressly saved by
the warrant.
(2) Nothing in this section shall authorise the taking of any land occupied
by any building, yard, cemetery, burial ground, or in bona fide occupation as an
ornamental park or pleasure ground, except with the prior consent in writing of
the Leveki Mangafaoa or of the owner or of the Assembly.
(3) The procedure for taking land for public purposes under this section
shall be prescribed by Act.

12 Revocation of warrant taking land

(1) If any warrant under section 11 is made in error, or if the land so taken
or any part of it is found not to be required for the purpose for which it was taken,
Cabinet may, by warrant, at any time before compensation has been paid in respect
of it, revoke the warrant either wholly or as to any part of the land so taken.
(2) A warrant so revoked shall, so far as revoked, be deemed never to have
been made, and the land shall accordingly be deemed to have remained vested in
the persons formerly entitled to it or to their successors in title.
(3) Any person interested in the land and suffering loss or damage by the
making and revocation of any such warrant taking it shall be entitled to
compensation in the same manner, with all necessary modifications, as in the case
of compensation for land taken.

13 Compensation for land taken

(1) When any land has been so taken for a public purpose, all persons
having in respect of that land any right, title, estate, or interest which is extinguished
or divested by the taking of the land shall be entitled to compensation for it from
the Crown.
(2) Cabinet may within 60 days after the date when the land taken has
vested in the Crown, offer to the persons entitled to share in the compensation
such sum by way of compensation as it thinks fit, and, if the offer is not accepted
by all such persons within 30 days after it has been communicated to them, or if
no such offer is made within the 60 days aforesaid, the compensation shall be
assessed and awarded by the Land Court, either on the application of Cabinet or
on application of any person claiming the compensation or share in it.
(3) The compensation so awarded to any person shall constitute a debt
due to him by the Crown, and shall be payable out of the Niue Government
Account.
(4) In awarding any such compensation, the Court may direct that the
compensation, or any part of it, be paid to the Registrar of the Court for distribution
to the persons entitled to it.
(5) The receipt of the Registrar of the Court shall be a sufficient discharge
for any money so paid in the same manner as if that money had been then paid to
the persons entitled to it.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1235

14 Resumption of Crown land for public purposes

(1) The Cabinet may, by warrant, resume for any public purpose specified
in the warrant any Crown land held under lease or otherwise subject to any right,
title, or interest in any other person, and every such lease, right, title or interest
shall in accordance with the tenor of the warrant determine accordingly, save so
far as expressly preserved by it.
(2) All persons entitled to any lease, right, title, or interest so determined
shall be entitled to compensation in the same manner as in the case of land taken
for public purposes.

15 [Repealed]

16 Acquisition of land for public purposes

Cabinet may, for public purposes, purchase or otherwise acquire any Niuean
land or any undivided interest or acquire by grant, assignment, or otherwise any
lease, easement, profit a prendre, or other limited right, title, estate, or interest of or
in any such land.

17 Public purpose for which land held may be altered

Where any land has under this Part or the corresponding provisions of any
former Act been set aside as a reserve or taken or resumed or purchased or
otherwise acquired for any public purpose, the public purpose for which the land
is held may be varied or cancelled by Cabinet by warrant.

18 Control of Crown land by Cabinet

Cabinet may exercise on behalf of the Crown all rights of suit, entry, re­
entry, receipt of rents and profits, use, management, control, and possession vested
in the Crown in respect of any Crown land.

21 Ownership in Niuean land

All land in Niue which at 1 November 1969 is held by Niueans under Niuean
custom is hereby vested in the Crown as the trustee of owners of it, and shall be
held by the Crown subject to Niuean custom, and all such land is hereby declared
to be Niuean land accordingly, but shall remain subject to any right which may
have been lawfully acquired in respect of it before 1 November 1969 otherwise
than under Niuean custom.

22 Investigation of title to Niuean land

The Land Court shall have exclusive jurisdiction to investigate the title to
Niuean land and to determine the relative interests of the owners or occupiers of
any such land under this Act or any other enactment.

23 Niuean customs to be recognised

Every title to and estate or interest in Niuean land shall be determined
under Niuean custom and any Act of the Assembly or other enactment affecting
Niuean custom.
1236 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

24 No alienation of Niuean land

No person shall be capable of making any alienation of Niuean land or of
any interest in it, except as provided by Part 2 or under any other enactment.

25 For certain purposes Niuean land to be deemed Crown land

(1) For the purpose of preventing trespass or injury to Niuean land the
title to which has not been registered, or of recovering damages for any such
trespass or injury, or for the purpose of recovering possession of any such land
from any person in wrongful occupation of it, an action or other proceeding may
be brought by or on behalf of the Crown as if the land were Crown land.
(2) Nothing in this section shall be so construed as to take away or affect
any jurisdiction conferred upon the Land Court by this Act.
PART 4
LAND FOR CHURCH PURPOSES

26 Vesting of land for Church purposes

(1) The Land Court, if it is satisfied that any Niuean land has been at any
time given or set aside by the Leveki Mangafaoa, or, where there is no Leveki

Mangafaoa, the owners exclusively for Church purposes for the benefit of the

adherents of some Christian denomination, and that the Leveki Mangafaoa or the
owners, as the case may be, are willing that the land shall be exclusively so used
in perpetuity, and that no sufficient alienation or disposition of the land by way of
lease or otherwise has been made in pursuance and furtherance of the said gift or
setting aside, may make an order under this section vesting that land in any body
corporate to hold and administer it for such Church purposes as are specified in
the order.
(2) On application being made under this section, the Court may make
one or more orders, subject to such terms and conditions as the Court thinks fit to
impose, vesting the land in such body corporate as may be nominated by the
applicant.
(3) Every order made under this section shall take effect according to its
tenor, and the land affected by it shall vest in the body corporate without any
transfer or other instrument of assurance.

27 Land vested for Church purposes may be acquired by the Crown

Where any land vested in any body corporate or persons under section 26
is no longer required for the Church purposes specified in the vesting order, the
land may be acquired by the Crown under Part 2 and no compensation shall be
payable to any person in respect of it.

28 Existing records and instruments

All records, instruments, reservations, and generally all acts of authority
relating to the giving or setting aside of land for Church purposes subsisting and
in force at 1 November 1969 may be accepted by the Land Court as evidence in
support of any application under section 26.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1237
PART 5
THE LAND COURT

29 Qualifications of Judges

(1) Subject to articles 41(1) and 43 of the Constitution no person other than
a barrister or solicitor of not less than 7 years practice in Niue or in a country with
substantially identical land tenure system to that of Niue, or as a Judge of the
Land Court of such other country and can demonstrate an appreciation of the
customary land rules and practices of the Niuean people, may be appointed as a
Judge of the Land Court.
(2) With the exception of the Chief Justice who shall be the superior Judge
of the Land Court, other Judges of theCourt shall have seniority among themselves
according to the dates of their appointments as judges. If 2 or more of them are
appointed on the same day, they shall have the seniority according to the
precedence as such judges or, failing any such assignment, according to the order
they take the official oath under article 55C of the Constitution.
(3) Every permanent judge shall have seniority over every temporary
Judge.

30 Qualifications of Commissioners of the Land Court

(1) Subject to articles 46(2) and 47 of the Constitution and to this section
any barrister or solicitor with less than 7 years practice in Niue or any other persons
or officers of the Government of Niue (except the Registrar) possessing the desired
qualities and a good appreciation of Niuean customs in relation to land and other
land related matters and of good standing in the community, may be appointed a
Commissioner of the Land Court.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1), none of the following persons shall be
qualified to be appointed as a Commissioner of the Land Court, namely –
(a) A member of the Assembly;
(b) An officer of a political organisation;
(c) An undischarged bankrupt;
(d) A person with a criminal record (except for minor traffic offences);
and
(e) Ministers of religion.
(3) The rules of seniority of judges laid down in section 29 shall apply to
Commissioners as if the reference to judges in that section were a reference to
Commissioner.

31 Salaries and other remuneration

Subject to articles 44 and 49 of the Constitution there shall be paid to the
Chief Justice, Judges and Commissioners out of the Niue Government Account,
without further appropriation than this section the salaries and allowances set
out in the Schedule.

32-37 [Repealed]

38 Registrar and Deputy Registrar of Land Court

(1) There shall be a Registrar of the Court.
(2) The Registrar shall keep or cause to be kept such records of and in
relation to proceedings in the Land Court as may be prescribed.
(3) There may also be appointed a Deputy Registrar who shall, subject to
the control of the Registrar, possess, exercise, and perform the same powers,
functions, and duties as the Registrar, and every reference in any enactment to the
Registrar shall, so far as applicable, extend and apply to the Deputy Registrar
accordingly.
1238 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

39 Administrative officers

There shall be appointed in respect of the Land Court such clerks,
interpreters, and other administrative officers as may be necessary.

40 Records of Land Court

The records, plans, and documents relating to the business of the Land
Court shall be kept, and the administrative work of the Land Court shall be carried
on, at such places as the Chief Justice directs.

41 Registers

Registers shall be kept by the Registrar, in which shall be recorded minutes
of all applications made to the Court and of all orders and proceedings made or
had thereon.

42 Seal of the Land Court

(1) The Land Court shall have in the custody of each Judge and the Registrar
a seal which shall be the seal of the Court, and shall be used for sealing documents
which require to be sealed.
(2) The form or forms of seal shall be such as Cabinet determines.

43 Rules of Land Court

(1) The practice and procedure of the Land Court in all matters within its
jurisdiction shall be as prescribed by enactment.
(2) So far as the Rules of the Land Court do not extend, but subject to this
Act, the Court shall in all matters proceed in such manner as seems just and
convenient in that particular case.

44 Applications to Land Court

(1) The jurisdiction of the Land Court in any matter may be exercised on
the application of any person claiming to be interested in it, or on the application
of Cabinet of any person authorised by Cabinet in that behalf.
(2) In the course of the proceedings on any application, the Land Court
may, subject to this Act, Rules of Court, and any other enactment, without further
application and upon such terms as notice to parties and otherwise as the Court
thinks fit, proceed to exercise any other part of its jurisdiction the exercise of which
in those proceedings the Court thinks necessary or advisable.

45 Rehearings

(1) On the application of any person interested, the Land Court may grant
a rehearing of any matter either wholly or as to any part of it.
(2) On any such rehearing the Court may either affirm, vary, or annul its
former determination, and may exercise any jurisdiction which it might have
exercised on the original hearing.
(3) When a rehearing has been so granted, the period allowed for an appeal
shall not commence to run until the rehearing has been disposed of by a final
order of the Court.
(4) Any such rehearing may be granted on such terms as to costs and
otherwise as the Court thinks fit, and the granting or refusal of it shall be in the
absolute discretion of the Court.
(5) No order shall be so varied or annulled at any time after the signing
and sealing of it.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1239

46 Sittings of Land Court

(1) The times and places of the sittings of the Land Court shall be
determined by Rules of Court.
(2) The dates of the commencement of the ordinary sittings of the Court
for the period of 12 months commencing on 1 April in each year shall be published
in the Gazette before the commencement of that period or as soon as practicable
after the commencement of it.
(3) Special sittings may be held at such times and places as may be
appointed by the Chief Justice.

General Jurisdiction of the Land Court

47 Jurisdiction of the Land Court

(1) In addition to any jurisdiction specifically conferred upon the Land
Court by any enactment other than this section, the Land Court shall have exclusive
jurisdiction –
(a) To hear and determine any application to the Land Court relating
to the ownership, possession, occupation, or utilisation of Niuean
land, or to any right, title, estate or interest in Niuean land or in the
proceeds of any alienation of it;
(b) To determine the relative interests of the owners or the occupiers
in any Niuean land;
(c) To hear and determine any application for the appointment of a

Leveki Mangafaoa in respect of any Niuean land;

(d) To hear and determine any claim to recover damages for trespass
or any other injury to Niuean land;
(e) To grant an injunction against any person in respect of actual or
threatened trespass or any other injury to Niuean land;
(f) To grant an injunction prohibiting any person from dealing with or
doing any injury to any property which is the subject-matter of any
application to the Land Court;
(g) To create easements in gross over Niuean land;
(h) To make any order recording the determination of any matter
relating to land or any interest in it, whether provided for in this
Act or other enactment;
(i) To authorise the survey of any land.
(2) The grant of an easement under subsection (1)(g) may, if the Court thinks
fit, be made subject to the payment of compensation in respect of it, or to any
other conditions that the Court may impose.

47A Jurisdiction of Commissioners

(1) Subject to this section, Commissioners shall be empowered to exercise
any or all of the jurisdiction conferred upon the Land Court under section 47 in
addition to any other jurisdiction (whether judicial or administrative) conferred
upon the Judges or Commissioners by any enactment, but excluding those vested
exclusively in the Chief Justice.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1) and for the purposes of exercising the
jurisdiction conferred on the Land Court under section 47(1) the following
provisions shall apply –
(a) For the purposes of exercising the jurisdiction under section 47 (1)
(a), (b) and (i) not less than 5 Commissioners sitting together may
exercise such powers;
1240 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) In every other case (whether arising out of the remaining provisions of the said section 47(1) or of any other enactment) not less than 2
Commissioners sitting together may exercise such other powers, except where an enactment expressly empowers a Commissioner sitting alone to exercise any of the powers.
(3) All references in this Act or any enactment (including any rules of the
Land Court, regulations, orders or by-laws) to a Judge of the Land Court shall be
construed as applying to the Commissioners of the Land Court within the limits
of the jurisdiction conferred upon them under this section.

47B Commissioners may adjourn or decline jurisdiction

(1) Where proceedings has been commenced before Commissioners, the
Commissioners may, at any time before a final decision has been made –
(a) Decline to deal further with the matter and require that it shall be
dealt with by a Judge; or
(b) Where a question of law has arisen and it is necessary for such
question to be referred to a Judge, the Commissioners may adjourn
the proceedings until such question of law has been dealt with by a
Judge.
(2) Where the Commissioners decline to deal further with the matter, a
Judge shall deal with such matter by way of a rehearing.

47C Decision of majority to be decision of Land Court

(1) In any proceedings before Commissioners, the decision of the Land
Court shall be in accordance with the opinion of the majority of the Commissioners
present.
(2) If the Commissioners present are equally divided in opinion then the
Court shall decline from making a final decision and the opinions of all the
Commissioners present shall be referred to the Chief Justice and whichever opinion
the Chief Justice endorses that opinion shall form the decision of the Court.

47D Appeals from decisions of Commissioners

(1) Any party to any proceedings before Commissioners of the Land Court
may appeal from the judgment of the Commissioners to a Judge of the Land Court.
(2) Every such appeal shall be by way of rehearing and section 45 of this
Act and rule 39 of the Land Court Rules 1969 shall apply accordingly.

47E Attendance of Commissioners at Court

(1) The Registrar shall keep and update a list of Commissioners.
(2) Where the attendance of Commissioners are required at any sitting of
the Court, the Registrar shall summon as many Commissioners as he thinks
necessary to attend.

47F Legality of acts done by person no longer a Commissioner

The legality of anything done by a person while he is a Commissioner shall
not be affected by his ceasing to be a Commissioner, but anything done by any
person after he has ceased to be a Commissioner in purported exercise of any of
the powers or duties of such office shall be void.

47G Action against a Commissioner

No action shall be brought against any Commissioner for any act done by
him in the course of exercising his duties.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1241

48 Jurisdiction conferred on Land Court

(1) In addition to the jurisdiction elsewhere in this Act conferred upon the
Land Court, Cabinet may confer upon that Court, as effectually as if it were
conferred by this Act, jurisdiction in any matter or question affecting exclusively
the rights of Niueans in any property, and thereupon the Land Court shall have
full jurisdiction to determine that matter or question.
(2) Any order of the Land Court in any such matter or question shall be
valid and binding in law, and may be dealt with as nearly as may be in the same
manner as an order or determination of a similar nature made by the Court in the
exercise of the jurisdiction conferred upon it by this Act.

49 Powers of Judges

A Judge sitting alone or any 2 or more Judges sitting together may exercise
all the powers of the Land Court.

50 Proceedings in Land Court before different Judges

Proceedings in the Land Court may be continued before a Judge or Judges
other than the Judge or Judges before whom the proceedings were commenced.

Orders of Land Court

51 Procedure with respect to the making of orders

(1) (a) The substance of every final order of the Land Court shall be
pronounced orally in open court.
(b) Subject to subsection (5), every such order shall take effect according
to its tenor as from the commencement of the day on which it is so
pronounced.
(c) A minute of the order shall forthwith be entered in the records of
the Land Court.
(2) As soon as practicable after the entry in the records of a minute, the
order shall be drawn up in writing under the seal of the Land Court and shall be
signed as hereinafter provided.
(3) Any such order may be signed by the Judge by whom it was made or
by any other Judge of the Land Court.
(4) (a) The order drawn up, sealed, and signed as hereinbefore provided
shall be dated as of the date of the minute and shall relate back to
that date.
(b) The validity and operation of all intermediate orders, instruments,
proceedings, and transactions shall be determined accordingly.
(5) No order shall be questioned or invalidated on the ground of any
variance between the order as so drawn up, sealed, and signed and the minute
thereof; and in the case of any variance the order shall prevail over and supersede
the minute.
(6) Any order may be made subject to the performance of conditions within
such time as may be limited in that behalf in the order and, in any such case, the
Land Court, without further application but subject to the giving of such notices
(if any) as the Land Court may direct, may amend or cancel the order on the
failure to comply with the conditions within the time limited as aforesaid.
(7) No order made under Part 4 shall be sealed and signed until and unless
there has been drawn or endorsed on it a plan of the land affected by it sufficient
to identify the land and the boundaries.
1242 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(8) Except with the leave of the Land Court, no order from which there is a right of appeal shall issue from the office of the Land Court before the time allowed for appeal has expired or, in the event of an appeal, before the appeal has been duly disposed of.
(9) (a) The Land Court may at any time cause duplicates of any order to be sealed and signed.
(b) Every such duplicate shall have the word “Duplicate” written or stamped on it, and shall have the same evidentiary value as the order of which it is a duplicate.
(10) Where by any enactment provision is made for production of an order of the Land Court for purposes of registration or otherwise, it shall be sufficient compliance with that provision if a duplicate of the order, or a copy of it issued under the seal of the Court and certified by a Judge or the Registrar as a correct copy, is so produced.

52 Orders bind all persons interested

Every order of the Land Court determining or affecting the title to Niuean
land or to any estate or interest in it shall bind all persons having any interest in
that land, whether or not they are parties to or have notice of the proceedings in
which the order is made, and whether or not they are subject to any disability.

53 Validity of orders

(1) No order of the Land Court shall be invalid because of any error,
irregularity, or defect in the form thereof or in the practice or procedure of the
Court even though by reason of that error, irregularity, or defect the order was
made without or in excess of jurisdiction.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) shall apply to any order which in its nature
or substance and independently of its form or of the practice or procedure of the
court was made without or in excess of jurisdiction.
(3) Every order made by the Land Court shall be presumed in all courts
and in all proceedings to have been made within the jurisdiction of the court,
unless the contrary is proved or appears on the face of the order.

54 Annulment of orders obtained by fraud

The Land Court may at any time annul any order obtained by fraud.

55 [Repealed by 2004/270]

56 Enforcement of charges

(1) When any charge is imposed either by this Act or by the Land Court
upon any Niuean land or upon any interest in it, that Court may at any time for
the purpose of enforcing that charge appoint a receiver in respect of the property
so charged.
(2) A receiver so appointed shall be entitled, unless the Land Court
otherwise orders, to the possession of the property and to the receipt of the rents
and profits.
(3) Any person who obstructs any such receiver in the execution of his
office shall be guilty of contempt of the Land Court.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1243

57 Registration of orders affecting title to land

(1) Any order of the Land Court affecting or relating to the title to land
may be registered against the title to that land.
(2) For the purposes of registration the order shall be filed in the Land
Registry Office, and the Registrar shall thereupon, subject to the provisions of any
enactment, register the order accordingly.
(3) Nothing in this section shall affect or modify any special provisions
made in any other enactment for the registration of any such order.

Contempt of Court

58 Contempt of Court defined

(1) Every person is guilty of contempt of the Land Court who –
(a) Knowingly disobeys any order of that Court or of a Judge of it,
otherwise than by making default in the payment of any sum of
money payable under such an order; or
(b) Uses any abusive, insulting, offensive, or threatening words or
behaviour in the presence or hearing of the court; or
(c) Assaults, resists, or obstructs, or incites any other person to assault,
resist, or obstruct, any constable or officer of the court in serving
any process of the court or in executing any warrant or order of the
court or of a Judge of it; or
(d) By any words or behaviour in the presence or hearing of the court,
obstructs in any manner the proper and orderly administration of
justice in the court; or
(e) Does any other thing which elsewhere in this Act or in any other
enactment is declared to be a contempt of the Land Court; or
(f) Aids, abets, counsels, procures, or incites any other person to commit
contempt of the Land Court.
(2) Every person shall be guilty of contempt of the Land Court who –
(a) Having been served with a summons requiring him to appear before
the Land Court at a time and place mentioned in the summons,
neglects or fails without sufficient cause shown by him to appear
or to produce any document which he is so required to produce; or
(b) Whether summoned to attend or not, is present in court and, being
required to give evidence or to produce any document then in his
possession, refuses, without sufficient cause shown by him, to be
sworn or to give evidence or to produce that document; or
(c) Having been sworn to give evidence in any proceedings, neglects
or fails without sufficient cause shown by him to appear at such
time as the Court directs for the purpose of giving further evidence
in the proceedings.

59 Penalty for contempt

Every person who commits contempt of the Land Court is liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or a fine not exceeding 1 penalty
unit.

60 Jurisdiction in contempt

The offence of contempt of the Land Court shall be punishable either –
(a) By the Land Court in the ordinary course of its criminal jurisdiction;
or
(b) By the Land Court under sections 61 to 64.
1244 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

61 Contempt in face of the Court

(1) If the contempt is committed in the presence or hearing of the Land
Court, any Judge there and then sitting in that Court may without order or warrant
direct any constable, officer of the court, or other person to arrest the person so
guilty of contempt, and to bring him before the court.
(2) The Court may thereupon, after giving the person so arrested a
reasonable opportunity of being heard in his defence, by warrant under the seal
of the Court, either commit him to prison for a term not exceeding 6 months or
order him to pay a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

62 Arrest on warrant

If contempt of the Land Court is committed otherwise than in the sight or
hearing of the Court, any Judge of that Court may issue his warrant for the arrest
of the offender or may summon him to appear before the Court.

63 Conviction by Land Court

On the appearance of the offender before the Land Court, the Court may,
after giving him a reasonable opportunity to be heard in his defence, by warrant
under the seal of the Court, either commit him to prison for a term not exceeding
6 months or order him to pay a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

64 Enforcement of fine

If a fine imposed by the Court for contempt under the foregoing provisions
is not paid, the Court may, by warrant under its seal, commit the offender to prison
for a term not exceeding 6 months.

65 Discharge of persons in contempt

Any person so committed to prison for contempt or for default in payment
of a fine may be at any time discharged, and any fine so imposed may be at any
time remitted in whole or in part, either by order of the Land Court or by warrant
under the hand of Cabinet.

66 Jurisdiction in contempt may be exercised at any time or place

Notwithstanding this Act, the jurisdiction hereby conferred upon the Land
Court in respect of contempt of court may be exercised by any Judge of that court
sitting at any time and place which he thinks fit.

67-68 [Repealed]

PART 6
THE COURT OF APPEAL

69-74 [Repealed by 2004/270]

75 Appeals from Land Court

(1) Except as expressly provided to the contrary in this Act, the Court of
Appeal shall have jurisdiction to hear and determine appeals from any final order
of the Land Court, whether made under the principal Act or this Act or under any
other authority in that behalf.
(2) Any such appeal may be brought as of right at the suit of any party to
the proceedings in which the order is made, or at the suit of any person bound by
the order or interested in it.
(3) Every such appeal shall be commenced by notice of appeal given in
the prescribed manner within 2 months after the date of the minute of the order
appealed from.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1245

76 Appeals from provisional determination as to title to Niuean land

(1) By leave of the Land Court, an appeal shall lie to the Court of Appeal
from any provisional or preliminary determination of the Land Court made in the
course of any proceedings for the ascertainment of any right, title, or interest in
Niuean land.
(2) Any such appeal may be brought at the suit of any person who is
interested in the determination appealed from, or who would be bound by a
partition order made under it.
(3) When leave to appeal is so given, the Land Court may either stay further
proceedings in the matter or continue the proceedings, but no final order shall be
made until the appeal has been finally disposed of or dismissed.
(4) When any such appeal has been determined by the Court of Appeal,
no further appeal shall lie as of right at the suit of any person from any final order
thereafter made in those proceedings by the Land Court so far as that order
conforms to the determination of the Court of Appeal.

77 Successive appeals in respect of same matter

Successive appeals to the Court of Appeal may be brought in respect of the
same order at the suit of different persons, but no matter determined on appeal
shall be again brought in question in any other appeal.

78 Powers of Court of Appeal on appeal

On any appeal, the Court of Appeal may do any one or more of the following
things –
(a) Affirm the order appealed from;
(b) Annul that order, with or without the substitution of any other order
therefor;
(c) Vary that order;
(d) Direct the Land Court to make such other or additional order as
the Court of Appeal thinks fit;
(e) Direct a new trial or rehearing by the Land Court;
(f) Make any order which the Land Court might have made in the
proceedings;
(g) Dismiss any appeal.

79 Dismissal of appeal for non-prosecution

If the appellant in any case does not prosecute his appeal with due diligence,
the respondent or any other person bound by or interested in the order appealed
from may apply either to the Land Court or to the Court of Appeal for an order
dismissing the appeal for non-prosecution; and, if such an order is made by either
court, the costs of the appeal and the security entered into (if any) by the appellant
shall be dealt with in such manner as that court may direct.

80 Variation deemed part of original order

(1) When an order of the Land Court is varied by the Court of Appeal, it
shall, as so varied, be deemed to remain and be an order of the Land Court and
the variation shall take and be deemed to have taken effect from the same date as
if the order had been originally made by the Land Court in that form.
(2) When an order of the Land Court is varied by the Court of Appeal, the
order as so varied shall be drawn up as an order of the Land Court and shall be
sealed with the seal of that Court and signed by the presiding Judge or by the
Chief Justice, and shall bear the same date as if no such appeal and variation had
1246 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
taken place; and the order as so drawn up shall supersede and take the place of the order as originally made, whether or not that order has been already drawn up, sealed, and signed.

81 Orders of Court of Appeal

(1) If on appeal the Court of Appeal makes (otherwise than by way of
variations as aforesaid) any order which the Land Court might have made in the
proceedings, a minute of the order shall be entered in the records of the Court of
Appeal and the order shall take effect as an order of the Court of Appeal as from
the commencement of the day of the making of it.
(2) As soon as practicable after the making of the order, it shall be drawn
up in writing under the seal of the Court of Appeal and the hand of the presiding
Judge or of the Chief Justice, and shall be dated as of the date of the minute.
(3) Subject to this section, section 51 with respect to orders drawn up, sealed,
and signed in the Land Court shall extend and apply to orders so drawn up, sealed,
and signed in the Court of Appeal.
(4) Sections 52 and 53 shall extend and apply to orders of the Court of
Appeal in the same manner as to orders of the Land Court.

82 Contempt

Sections 58 to 66 shall extend and apply to the Court of Appeal in the same
manner as to the Land Court.

83 Court of Appeal may order surveys

The Court of Appeal shall have the same powers with respect to the
authorisation of surveys as are conferred upon the Court and by section 47(1)(i).

84 Definition of “road”

PART 7
ROADS
(1) In this Part “road” means any land which under this Part or the corresponding provisions of any former Act has been declared as a road.
(2) Upon the declaration of any land as a road, it shall, subject to the public right of way on it, vest in the Crown, together with all materials and things of which the road is composed, or which are capable of being used for the purpose of the road and are placed or laid upon the road.

85 Public rights over roads

(1) Subject to the provisions of any enactment, the public shall have full
rights to pass and repass over any road.
(2) All roads shall be under the control of and may be formed, maintained,
and repaired by the Crown.

86 Warrant declaring existing roads

As soon as practicable after the commencement of this Act, the Registrar
shall prepare and deposit in the Land Registry Office a plan showing all land
which in his opinion has been used as of right by the public and ought to be
constituted as a road, and Cabinet shall by warrant, declare to be roads all land
shown on that plan as roads.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1247

87 Warrants declaring new roads

(1) Cabinet may, by warrant, declare any Crown land or Niuean land as a
road.
(2) For the purpose of this Part, it shall not be necessary to define the
boundary of any unsurveyed Crown land or Niuean land affected by any such road.

88 Warrants as to roads to be gazetted

Every warrant of Cabinet under this Part shall be under its hand and the
seal of Niue, and shall be published in the Gazette, and shall take effect according
to its tenor upon that publication or upon any later date specified in that behalf in
the warrant.

89 Access to land

(1) The Land Court may, by order, at any time declare any land to be subject
to a right of the public or of any person or class of persons to traverse that land for
the purpose of gaining access or improved access to any other land, subject to any
conditions which may be prescribed by the Court.
(2) The rights of any person under such an order shall be subject to an
obligation not to cause any damage to the land affected by the order or any crops
or improvements on it.
(3) The Court may, at the time of making the order, or at any time thereafter,
define by reference to a plan or map the route to be followed over the land; and, in
any case where the route is defined subsequent to the making of the order, the
Court may impose additional conditions or vary any conditions already made.
(4) No order shall be made declaring a right of access over Crown land
except with the consent in writing of the Cabinet.
(5) The declaration of any right of access over any land shall not affect the
ownership of the land.
(6) Any order made under this section may at any time be amended or
cancelled, if the Court thinks fit.

90 Closing of roads

(1) (a) Cabinet may, by warrant, close in whole or in part any road.
(b) No road or part of any road shall be closed under this section, if –
(i) The area comprising the closed road or part will be left without
access to a road, either directly or by being added to adjoining
land which has direct access to some other road; or
(ii) Any land having direct access to that road or part will be left
having no direct access to any road.
(2) Where any road or part of any road has been closed under this section,
the Land Court may, on application by Cabinet, make an order vesting the whole
or any portion of the land comprised in the road or part that has been closed in the

Leveki Mangafaoa or, where there is no Leveki Mangafaoa, the owners of any adjoining

land which, when the road was constituted, was Niuean land.
(3) Any land vested under this section shall become subject to any
reservation, trust, right, title, interest or encumbrance to which the land with which
it is incorporated is then subject.
(4) By the same or a subsequent order, the Court may amend any existing
title to include in it the land comprised in the road or part of it that has been
closed as aforesaid; and the Registrar is hereby authorised to make all necessary
entries or amendments in the Land Register.
1248 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

91 Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 8
ADOPTION
“adopted child” means any person in respect of whom an adoption order is in force;
“adoption order” means an adoption order made by the Land Court; “adoptive parent” means any person who adopts a child under an adoption
order; and, in the case of an order made in favour of a husband and
wife on their joint application, means both the husband and wife; but
does not include a spouse who merely consents to an adoption;
“child” means a person who is under the age of 21 years;
“father”, in relation to any child born out of wedlock, means the natural
father.

92 Adoption by Niuean custom invalid

No adoption by Niuean custom, whether made before or after 1 November
1969 shall be of any force or effect, whether in respect of intestate succession or
otherwise.

93 Adoption by Niuean custom before 1 April 1916 by parent dying before

5 December 1921

Notwithstanding anything in section 92, in any case where before 1 April
1916 any child was adopted by Niuean custom and since that date and before 5
December 1921 the adopting parent has died, the adoption shall for all purposes
have the same operation and effect as that which is attributed by Niuean custom
to adoption by Niuean custom.

94 Validity of adoption registered before 1 April 1916

Any adoption lawfully made and registered in the Cook Islands Land Titles
Court in the exercise of its jurisdiction in Niue before and subsisting on 1 April
1916 and continuing to subsist at 1 November 1969, shall continue to have the
same force and effect as if lawfully made by an order of adoption under this Part.

95 Court may make adoption orders

(1) Subject to this Part, the Land Court may, upon an application made by
any person, whether domiciled in Niue or not, make an adoption order in respect
of any child, whether Niuean or European, and whether domiciled in Niue or not.
(2) An adoption order may be made on the application of spouses jointly
in respect of a child.
(3) An adoption order may be made in respect of the adoption of a child
by the mother or father or the child, either alone or jointly with his or her spouse.

96 Prohibition of payments in consideration of adoption

Except with the consent of the Court, it shall not be lawful for any person
to give or receive or agree to give or receive any payment or reward in consideration
of the making of arrangements for an adoption or proposed adoption.

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

1249

97 Restrictions on making adoption orders

(1) No adoption order shall be made under this Part unless the Land Court
is satisfied that –
(a) The child to be adopted is under the age of 21 years at the date of
the filing of the application; and
(b) The applicant or, in the case of a joint application, one of the
applicants, has attained the age of 25 years and is at least 21 years
older than the child, or is the mother or father of the child; and
(c) The applicant (if unmarried) is at least 30 years older than the child;
and
(d) Where the child is female and the sole applicant is male, the
applicant is the father of the child, or there are special circumstances
which justify the making of an order; and
(e) The child, if in the opinion of the Court is above the age of 12 years,
consents to the adoption; and
(f) The applicant is a fit and proper person to have the care and custody
of the child and of sufficient ability to maintain the child, and the
adoption will not be contrary to the welfare and interests of the
child.
(2) In order to satisfy itself as to the matters mentioned in subsection (1)(f)
the Court shall call for a report on it by Cabinet or by an officer of the Niue Public
Service nominated for the purpose by Cabinet.
(3) No adopted child shall, in the lifetime of an adoptive parent and while
the adoption order remains in force, be adopted by any other person save the
husband or wife of that parent.

98 Consents to adoptions

(1) No adoption order shall be made without the consent of the parents or
of the surviving parent (if any) of the child, whether that child is born in lawful
wedlock or not, but no such consent shall be required from any parent if the Court
is satisfied that the child has been deserted by that parent, or that that parent is for
any reason unfit to have the care and custody of the child, or if the Court for any
other reason whatsoever considers that the consent of that parent should be
dispensed with.
(2) Every consent given under subsection (1) shall be given in writing and
witnessed by one of the persons specified in section 78(1) of the principal Act, and
every such witness shall certify that the parent signing the consent fully
understands the effect of an adoption order.
(3) Where the application for an adoption order is made by either a husband
or a wife alone, no order shall be made without the consent of the spouse of the
applicant, save that no such consent shall be required if the Court is satisfied that
the spouses are living apart and that their separation is likely to be permanent.

99 Effect of adoption order

Every adoption order shall have both in Niue and in New Zealand the
same operation and effect as an adoption order made under the Adoption Act
1955 has by virtue of section 16(1) and (2) of that Act.
1250 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

100 Adoption order may be varied or discharged

(1) The Land Court may vary or discharge any adoption order subject to
such terms and conditions as it thinks fit, on the application of any adoptive parent
or of the adopted child.
(2) The Land Court may, subject to such terms and conditions as it thinks
fit, discharge any adoption made in any place outside Niue either before or after
1 November 1969 if –
(a) The person adopted is living and is domiciled in Niue; and
(b) Every living adoptive parent is domiciled in Niue.
(3) No application for discharge of any adoption shall be made without
the prior approval of Cabinet and no adoption order or adoption shall be
discharged unless the adoption order was made by mistake as to a material fact in
consequence of a material misrepresentation to the Court or to any person
concerned.
(4) Where the Court discharges an adoption order or adoption as aforesaid,
it may confer on the person to whom the order or adoption related such surname
with such first or Christian name as the Court thinks fit; but, if it does not do so,
the names of the person shall not be affected by the discharge of the order.
(5) The discharge of an adoption order shall have both in Niue and in New
Zealand the same effect as the discharge of an adoption order under the Adoption
Act 1955 has by virtue of section 20(b) of that Act.

101 Adoption orders under Cook Islands Amendment Act 1921

(1) Every adoption order duly made under section 9 of the Cook Islands
Amendment Act 1921 and in force at 1 November 1969 shall for all purposes have
the same force and effect as an order of adoption lawfully made under this Part,
and the person named in it as the adopted child shall be deemed to have been
lawfully adopted as from the date of his adoption by Niuean custom, or, where
that date has not been proved to the satisfaction of the Court, from such date as
may be specified in the order made under the said section 9.
(2) Section 100 shall apply to every adoption under the said section 9.

102-103 [Spent]

104 [Repealed]

PART 9

Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968

SCHEDULE SCHEDULE 1

[Repealed]

––––––––––––––––––––––––

1251

Class

JO 04

JO 03

Step

15

14

13

12

11

SCHEDULE 2

CLASSIFICATION AND REMUNERATION SCALE FOR JUDICIARY

Daily Hourly Annual Designation

Rate Rate Allowance

$500 $160 $5,000 Chief Justice

$450 $160 $4,700 Appeal Judge

$400 $150 $4,100 High Court Judge

$375 $150 $4,000

$350 $150 $3,900

10 $36 $1,100

09 $33 $1,000

08 $30 $900

07 $27 $800

06 $24 $700

05 $21 $600

04 $19 $500

03 $17 $400

JO 02 02 $15 $300 Commissioners

JO 01 01 $13 $200 Justice of the Peace

(1) Excepting the Chief Justice and any full time judiciary appointee, all fee payments together with the annual allowance shall be paid quarterly in arrears provided however, the full annual allowance shall only be payable if the judiciary member has earned fee payments of four times the annual allowance. If less than four times the annual allowance has been earned in fees then the judiciary member shall be paid an equivalent proportion of the annual allowance.

(2) Justices of the Peace –

Lay person Steps 1-3

Legally qualified Steps 3-6

Commissioners –

Lay person Steps 2-8

Legally qualified Steps 6-11

Judges

High Court Steps 11-13

Chief Justice/Appeal Court Judges Steps 14-15

The gradings are not related to the Niue Public Service grading system nor to the previous judiciary gradings.

1252 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1253

NIUE ASSEMBLY ACT 1966

1966/33 – 1 February 1966

31 Chief Electoral Officer to give public notice of election and nomination day

32 By-elections

Nominations

33 Nomination of candidates

34 Consent to nomination

35 Deposit by candidate

36 Acceptance or rejection of nomination

37 Withdrawal of nomination

38 Advertisement of nominations

39 Insufficient number of nominations

40 Unlawful nominations

41 Procedures where election not contested

Contested Elections

42 If necessary, poll to be taken

43 Form of ballot papers

Death of Candidate

44 Death before close of nominations

45 Death after close of nominations

13A Common Electoral Roll

14 Compulsory registration by electors

15 Place of residence

16 Application for enrolment of electors

17 Procedure for registration

18 Objections to registration

19 Objection by an elector

20 Objection by Registrar

21 Determination of objections

22 Closing of rolls

23 Printing of copies

24 Supplementary rolls

25 Inspection of rolls and supply of copies

26 Closing of roll for by-election

27 Effect of closing of rolls

28 Offences in relation to enrolment

29 Effect of registration

PART 4

CONDUCT OF ELECTIONS

General Elections and By-Elections

30 Clerk of the Assembly gives notice to Chief

Electoral Officer

Polling at Elections

46 Polling places

47 Allocation of Officers

48 Polling booths, ballot boxes, ballot papers

49 Returning Officers, poll clerks, and

interpreters

50 Returning Officers, poll clerks and

interpreters to make declaration

51 Scrutineers

52 Hours of polling

53 Place of ordinary voting

The Ballot

54 Ballot box to be kept locked during poll

55 Persons not to remain in polling booth

56 Voters not to be spoken to in booth

57 Questions may be put to voter

58 Issue of ballot papers

59 Method of voting

60 Spoilt ballot papers

61 Blind or disabled voters

62 Procedure when second vote given in same

name

1254 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

81 Erasing and altering official mark

82 Offences

83 Property in Chief Electoral Officer

84 Infringement of secrecy

PART 4

CORRUPT PRACTICES

85 Corrupt practices

86 Bribery

87 Treating

88 Undue influence

89 Personation

PART 5

DISPUTED ELECTIONS

90 Election petitions

91 Candidate may oppose petition

92 Time for holding inquiry

93 Powers of Judge on inquiry

94 Certain irregularities

95 Result of inquiry

96 Persons committing irregularities to be

prosecuted

97 Costs of inquiry

98 Determination by Court final

PART 6

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

99 Notification of bankruptcy and death

100 Printing and forms

101 Form and transmission of documents

102 Offences

103 General penalty for offences

104 Validation of irregularities

105 Regulations

SCHEDULE

To provide for the qualifications and disqualifications of electors and candidates, the mode of electing members of the Assembly and the terms and conditions of their membership

1 Short title

This is the Niue Assembly Act 1966.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“announce” means make generally known in Niue by word of mouth or
by any other practicable means;
“candidate” means any registered elector capable of being elected and
nominated for election;

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1255
“Chief Electoral Officer” means the Chief Electoral Officer appointed under section 3, and includes any person authorised to exercise the powers, duties and functions of the Chief Electoral Officer;
“Common Electoral Roll” means the roll comprising the several village constituencies;
“constituency” means a constituency specified in section 5;
“corrupt practice” means any of the offences defined by this Act to be a
corrupt practice;
“election” means an election of a member of the Niue Assembly;
“elector” in relation to any constituency means a person registered, or
qualified to be registered, as an elector of that constituency;
“electoral officer” means any officer appointed under sections 3 and 4;
“general election” means an election which takes place after the dissolution
or expiration of the Niue Assembly;
“member” means a member of the Assembly;
“nomination day”, in relation to any election, means the day appointed by
public notice as the latest day for the nomination of candidates;
“notice in writing” includes notice by telegram or radio or other similar
means;
“official mark”, in relation to any document, means any mark enabling the
identification of the polling booth or office in which that document
was issued;
”polling day”, in relation to any election, means the day appointed by public
notice for that election for the polling to take place if a poll is required;
“presiding officer” means an electoral officer appointed to preside and
actually presiding at any polling booth on the day of polling;
“public notice”, in relation to any act, matter, or thing required to be publicly
notified, means the making of the act, matter, or thing generally known
in Niue by any practicable means in addition to publication in the

Gazette;

“registered elector” means an elector whose name is entered on any electoral
roll;
“Registrar” and “Registrar in charge” means any person appointed as the
Registrar under section 4, and includes any person authorised to exercise
the powers, duties and functions of the Registrar;
“resident”, in relation to any constituency, means any resident of Niue who
resides in that constituency and has resided there for at least 3 months
immediately preceding the date of his application for registration
pursuant to section 14;
“resident of Niue” , in relation to any applicant for registration as an elector
under section 14, means a person who is deemed to be ordinarily
resident in Niue and has been ordinarily resident throughout the period
of 3 months immediately preceding his application for enrolment or,
as the case may be, his nomination as a candidate, and has at some
period resided continuously in Niue for not less than 12 months;
“reside” in relation to any constituency has the meaning assigned to it under
section 15;
“Returning Officer” means a Returning Officer appointed under this Act
and includes any person authorised to exercise the powers, duties and
functions of a Returning Officer;
“roll” means an electoral roll or a supplementary roll made in the manner
provided by this Act containing the names of electors;
1256 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“transmit” means pass on by telegram, radio or other similar means.
(2) In this Act a reference to a numbered form is a reference to the form so
numbered in the Schedule.

3 Chief Electoral Officer

PART 1
ELECTORAL OFFICERS
(1) The Niue Public Service Commission shall appoint –
(a) A Chief Electoral Officer, who shall have and exercise the powers
and duties conferred on him by this Act; and
(b) A Deputy Chief Electoral Officer, to act in the case of the illness,
absence, death, or removal of the Chief Electoral Officer.
(2) Every Deputy Chief Electoral Officer, while so acting, shall exercise the
duties and shall have the powers and authorities of the Chief Electoral Officer
and the fact that he so acts shall be sufficient evidence of his authority to do so.

4 Electoral Officers

(1) The Niue Public Service Commission shall appoint –
(a) A Registrar for each electoral roll, who shall be in charge of the roll
in respect of which he is appointed;
(b) A Returning Officer for each constituency, who shall be in charge
of the election in the constituency for which he is appointed;
(c) Such clerks and other officers as, in the opinion of the Cabinet, are
required to implement this Act;
(d) A substitute for any officer appointed under this section to act in
the case of the illness, absence, death, or removal of that officer.
The substitute, while so acting, shall exercise the duties and have
the powers and authorities of the officer for whom he is acting, and
the fact that any substitute so acts shall be sufficient evidence of his
authority to do so.
(2) Any reference in this Act to one of the officers appointed under this
section shall be deemed to include any substitute appointed for that officer.
(3) Every person appointed as aforesaid shall exercise his duties and
functions subject to the control of the Chief Electoral Officer, and shall comply
with any directions received from him.
(4) With the approval of the Chief Electoral Officer, every Returning Officer
may appoint as many deputies and poll clerks as he deems necessary for the
effective taking of the poll at every polling booth, and every such deputy shall
have and may exercise in and about the polling booth for which he is appointed
all the powers and duties of a Returning Officer, subject to the control of the
Returning Officer by whom he is appointed.
(5) No Returning Officer shall hold any official position in connection with
any political organisation.
(6) Any person may be appointed to hold 2 or more offices under this
section and section 3.
(7) No candidate shall act as a scrutineer and no person holding any office
in or being a member of any political organisation shall be an officer appointed
under this section.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1257

5 Constituencies

(1) There shall be 14 constituencies for the election of members of the Niue
Assembly and each constituency shall have the name and comprise each of the
villages of Alofi North, Alofi South, Avatele, Hakupu, Hikutavake, Lakepa, Liku,
Makefu, Mutalau, Namukulu, Tamakautoga, Toi, Tuapa and Vaiea.
(2) Each constituency shall consist of the electors entitled under section 13
to have their names entered on the roll for that constituency.
PART 2
QUALIFICATIONS OF MEMBERS

6 Registered electors may be members unless disqualified

(1) Subject to this Act every person registered as an elector of any
constituency, but no other person, is qualified to be a candidate and to be elected
a member for that or any other constituency.
(2) A person shall not be so elected –
(a) If he is disqualified for registration as an elector under any provision
of this Act; or
(b) If he is an undischarged bankrupt.

7 Removal of name from roll without cause

Any person duly qualified as an elector who has been registered on any
electoral roll but whose name has become removed from that roll through no
fault of his own shall not, by reason only of not being registered as an elector, be
disqualified from becoming a candidate and being elected for any constituency,
but in every such case he shall forward to the Chief Electoral Officer, at the time
when he sends his consent to be nominated, a statutory declaration to the effect
that he is not disqualified as an elector for the constituency in respect of which he
was previously registered under this Act, that he still retains that qualification
and that his name has been removed from the roll of that constituency through no
fault of his own.

8 Effect of registration on wrong roll

The nomination of any person as a candidate for election, or his election as
a member shall not be questioned on the ground that, though entitled to be
registered as an elector of any constituency, he was not in fact registered as an
elector of that constituency but was registered as an elector of some other
constituency.

9 How vacancies created

The seat of a member shall be declared to be vacant by the Chief Electoral
Officer by public notice under his hand –
(a) If he fails to take the Oath of Allegiance as prescribed by the
Constitution or to make an affirmation instead of that Oath; or
(b) If on an election petition the Court declares his election void; or
(c) If he dies; or
(d) If he resigns his seat; or
(e) If, on 3 consecutive sitting days, the member fails, without the
permission of the Speaker, to attend the meetings of the Assembly
or of any committee of the Assembly; or
(f) If he ceases to reside in Niue; or
(g) If he becomes a bankrupt within the meaning of the bankruptcy
laws in force in Niue; or
1258 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(h) If he is convicted in Niue or any other part of the Commonwealth of any offence punishable by death or imprisonment for a term of one year or upwards or is convicted in Niue of a corrupt practice; or
(i) If he becomes of unsound mind and is so certified by 2 Medical Officers or by one Medical Officer and a graduate of the Fiji School of Medicine; or
(j) If he becomes a national of or adheres to any state with which Her
Majesty is at war.

10 Tenure of office

(1) Every member who has been elected under this Act shall take office on
the day on which the warrant declaring his election is signed by the Chief Electoral
Officer under sections 41 and 70.
(2) The seat of a member, unless previously vacated, shall become vacant
at the end of the day next preceding the day on which the members elected at the
next ensuing general election take office.

11 Form of resignation

A member who is not a Minister may resign his seat by writing under his
hand addressed and delivered to the Clerk of the Assembly.
PART 3
ELECTORS AND ELECTORAL ROLLS

12 Qualifications of electors

(1) Subject to this Act, a person shall be qualified to be registered as an
elector of any constituency if that person –
(a) Is either –
(i) a New Zealand citizen; or
(ii) a permanent resident of Niue as defined by the Entry Residence
and Departure Act 1985; and,
(b) Has at some period resided continuously in Niue for not less than
3 years; and
(c) Has been ordinarily resident in Niue throughout the period of 12
months immediately preceding application for enrolment as an
elector or, as the case may be, nomination as a candidate;
(d) He is of or over the age of 18 years; and
(e) He has not been convicted in Niue or in any other part of the
Commonwealth of any offence punishable by death or by
imprisonment for a term of one year or upwards, or has been
convicted in Niue of a corrupt practice, unless in each case he has
received a free pardon or has undergone the sentence or punishment
to which he was adjudged for the offence; and
(f) He is not of unsound mind; and
(g) He is a resident of that constituency.
(2) For the purposes of this section a person shall be deemed to be ordinarily
resident in Niue if, and only if –
(a) He is actually residing in Niue; or
(b) Having been actually resident in Niue with the intention of residing
there indefinitely, he is outside Niue but has, and has ever since he
left Niue an intention to return and reside there indefinitely.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1259
(3) Any person who has been outside Niue continuously for any period of more than 3 years, otherwise than for the purpose of undergoing a course of education or of technical training or instruction during the whole or substantially the whole of that period, shall be deemed not to have been actually resident in Niue during that period with the intention of residing there indefinitely.

13 Constituency Electoral rolls

(1) There shall be a constituency electoral roll for each constituency and
the Registrar in charge of that roll shall compile and keep, as provided herein, a
constituency electoral roll for the constituency for which he is appointed.
(2) (a) Every person qualified to be registered as an elector shall, subject
to this Act, be entitled to have his name entered upon the roll of the
constituency of which he is a resident.
(b) Every person who is so qualified but is not a resident of any
constituency shall be entitled to register in such constituency as the
Chief Electoral Officer determines.

13A Common Electoral roll

There shall be a common electoral roll to be kept and compiled by the Chief
Electoral Officer which shall comprise the rolls of the several village constituencies
established under this Act.

14 Compulsory registration of electors

(1) Every person who is or becomes qualified to be registered as an elector
shall make application in the prescribed form to the Registrar in charge of the roll
for the constituency for registration as an elector –
(a) –
(b) Within one month after the date on which he first becomes qualified
to be registered as an elector;
(c) Being an elector registered on the roll for any constituency, within
one month after the date on which he becomes qualified to be
registered on the roll of another constituency.
(2) No person shall be entitled to be registered as an elector on more than
one constituency electoral roll.

15 Place of residence

A person shall be deemed to reside where he has his usual place of abode
at any material time or during any material period, notwithstanding his occasional
absence from it, and notwithstanding his occasional absence on leave from his
occupation or employment.

16 Application for enrolment by electors

Every person required to apply for registration as an elector shall deliver
or send by post to the Registrar in charge of the roll on which the applicant is
entitled to have his name entered an application and declaration in form 1.

17 Procedure for registration

(1) Every applicant shall sign his application in the presence of any elector
or electoral officer or a Postmaster, who shall add his signature in witness of it.
(2) If the Registrar in charge of the roll is satisfied after due inquiry that
any claim for registration as aforesaid is valid, he shall forthwith enter the name
of the applicant on the roll.
1260 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) If the Registrar is not so satisfied, he shall, within 3 working days following the receipt of the application, notify the applicant in writing of his objection to enter the applicant’s name on the roll; and the applicant may, within
3 days of receipt of that notice, apply to the Niue Public Service Commission to determine his claim; and the Niue Public Service Commission, whose decision shall be final, shall order the name of the applicant either to be entered on the roll or not to be so entered, and the Registrar shall comply with the order accordingly. (4) Every Registrar who enters the name of any applicant on any roll shall forthwith give notice in form 2 to the Registrar of the constituency (if any) for which the applicant has stated that he was previously registered, and the Registrar receiving the notice shall forthwith remove from his roll the name of the applicant or, as the case may be, inform the Registrar giving the notice that the applicant
was not registered on that roll.
(5) It shall be the duty of every Registrar to make the roll of which he is in
charge as complete as possible, and with that object to place on it the name of
every person who has transmitted an application to the Registrar and of whose
qualifications he is satisfied.
(6) It shall further be the duty of every Registrar to assure himself of the
right of every registered elector to have his name retained on the roll, and to remove
from the roll of which he is in charge the name of every person who –
(a) Has died; or
(b) Is no longer possessed of the qualifications for an elector; or
(c) Ceases to reside within the constituency.
(7) When the Registrar removes any name from the roll under subsection
(6)(b) or (c) he shall, within 3 working days, notify the elector that his name has
been so removed and thereupon the provisions of subsection (3) shall, as far as
applicable and with the necessary modifications, apply.
(8) Every registered elector shall give notice in writing to the Registrar in
charge within one month of any change of his or her name by marriage or
otherwise; and the Registrar shall, after verification of the particulars contained
in the notice, amend the roll accordingly.

18 Objections to registration

Any name on any roll may be objected to either by the Registrar in charge
of that roll or by an elector whose name appears on that roll, on the ground that
the person whose name is objected to is not qualified to be registered or is not
qualified to be registered on the roll on which his name appears.

19 Objection by an elector

If the objection is by an elector, the following provisions shall apply –
(a) The objection shall be in writing lodged with the Registrar in charge
setting forth the grounds thereof, and may be in form 3;
(b) On receipt of the objection, the Registrar in charge shall forthwith
give notice in writing to the person objected to, setting forth the
objection and the grounds thereof;
(c) If the person objected to does not, within 5 clear days after the service
of the notice, cause his name to be removed from the roll on which
his name appears, or satisfy the Registrar that he is entitled to have
his name retained on that roll, the Registrar shall transmit the
objection with the reply (if any) received from the person objected
to and with any comments or recommendations the Registrar may
wish to make, to the Niue Public Service Commission.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1261

20 Objection by Registrar

If the objection is by the Registrar in charge of any roll, the following
provisions shall apply –
(a) The Registrar shall give notice in writing to the person objected to
of the grounds of the objection and intimate in the notice that, unless
notice of appeal is given within a time stated (being not less than 4
clear days), the name of the person objected to will be removed
from the roll without further proceedings;
(b) The notice of objection shall be in form 4, and the form of notice of
appeal set out in that form shall be annexed to it;
(c) If the person objected to does not, within the time stated in the
notice, satisfy the Registrar that he is entitled to have his name
retained on the roll, or fails to give notice of appeal, the Registrar
shall remove the name forthwith;
(d) If notice of appeal is duly given, the Registrar, if he is satisfied that
the appellant is entitled to have his name retained on the roll, shall
withdraw his objection and notify him accordingly, but, if he is not
so satisfied, he shall transmit his objection and the appeal, together
with any comments on it he may wish to make, to the Niue Public
Service Commission.

21 Determination of objections

The Niue Public Service Commission shall determine any objection
transmitted to it, after such investigation as it deems necessary, and shall direct
the Registrar in charge to retain the name objected to on the roll on which it appears
or, as the case may be, to remove it therefrom, or to transfer it through the Chief
Electoral Officer to any other roll, or to make such amendment of any roll as may
be necessary to give effect to the determination, and every such determination of
the Niue Public Service Commission shall be final.

22 Closing of rolls

(1) (a) Before every general election all electoral rolls shall be closed on a
date to be fixed for each roll by the Chief Electoral Officer.
(b) Different dates may be so fixed for different rolls.
(2) The Chief Electoral Officer shall give public notice of the date fixed for
the closing of each roll at least 10 clear days before the date so fixed.

23 Printing of copies

(1) As soon as practicable after the closing of any roll the Registrar in charge
shall cause the roll to be printed, containing the names, residences, occupations
and sex of the persons included in it, arranged and numbered consecutively in
alphabetical order of surnames, of all persons whose names are lawfully entered
on it.
(2) Each roll shall be in form 5, and shall be issued under the hand of the
Registrar in charge.

24 Supplementary rolls

The Registrar in charge may prepare a supplementary roll containing names
added to the roll after the printing of the main roll and an indication of names
removed from the main roll, and may cause the same to be printed, and every
supplementary roll shall be deemed to be a part of the main roll to which it refers.
1262 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

25 Inspection of rolls and supply

(1) Not later than 21 days before each general election, a printed copy of
each main roll shall be made available for inspection by the public without payment
during office hours at the office of the Registrar in charge and at such other places
in each constituency as the Registrar in charge directs.
(2) The Registrar in charge shall supply printed copies of the roll issued
under his hand to the Chief Electoral Officer, who shall supply each Returning
Officer with copies as they are required for the purpose of conducting any election.

26 Closing of roll for by-election

(1) Before any by-election, the relevant roll shall be closed on a date to be
fixed by the Chief Electoral Officer and at least 10 clear days before the date so
fixed the Chief Electoral Officer shall give public notice of it.
(2) Unless the Chief Electoral Officer thinks fit, a complete roll shall not be
printed for use at a by-election but a supplementary roll may, if the Chief Electoral
Officer thinks fit, be so printed and the provisions of this Part, as far as they are
applicable, shall apply accordingly.

27 Effect of closing of rolls

(1) The printed rolls compiled, issued, added to, or altered as herein
provided shall for the time being be the electoral rolls.
(2) (a) It shall not be lawful for the Registrar in charge to enter on or remove
from the roll the name of any person after the date fixed under this
Act for the closing of the roll until after the general election or by-
election in connection with which the roll has been closed.
(b) The Registrar in charge, on being satisfied that the name of any
person has been omitted or removed from the roll by mistake or
clerical error, or through false information, may add or restore the
name of that person to the roll at any time not later than 7 clear
days before the day appointed for an election.
(3) Any Registrar commits an offence who offends against this section,
and is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every name improperly
entered on or removed from the roll.

28 Offences in relation to enrolment

(1) Every person commits an offence, and is liable to a fine not exceeding
0.5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months, who
knowingly makes a false statement in any claim, application, or declaration referred
to in this Part.
(2) Every person commits an offence, and is liable to a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit, who –
(a) Wilfully misleads the Registrar in the compilation of any electoral
roll, or wilfully enters or causes to be entered in it any false or
fictitious name or qualification or the name of any person whom
he knows to be dead; or
(b) Signs the name of any other person, whether requested to do so or
not, or any false or fictitious name, to any form of claim, application
or objection for the purpose of this Part, either as claimant, applicant,
objector, or witness; or
(c) Signs his name as witness to any signature upon any such form of
claim or objection without either having seen that signature written
or hearing the person signing declare that the signature is his own
hand-writing and that the name so signed is his own proper name.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1263
(3) Every person commits an offence, and is liable to a fine not exceeding
0.5 penalty units who, having obtained possession of a claim for enrolment signed
by any other person for the purpose of being delivered to the Registrar for
enrolment, fails to so deliver it so that the claimant’s name is not placed on any
roll.

29 Effect of registration

Subject to this Act, every person registered on an electoral roll shall be
entitled –
(a) To either –
(i) nominate any other person registered on an electoral roll as a
candidate for election as a representative for the constituency
in respect of which the nomination is registered; or
(ii) to nominate any other person registered on an electoral roll as
a candidate for election as a representative for the common
electoral roll;
(b) To vote in the manner prescribed in article 16 of the Constitution.
PART 4
CONDUCT OF ELECTIONS

General Elections and By-Elections

30 Clerk of the Assembly gives notice to Chief Electoral Officer

For every general election and every by-election the Clerk of the Assembly
shall give notice in writing to the Chief Electoral Officer not less than 30 clear
days before the polling day fixed for that election.

31 Chief Electoral Officer to give public notice of election and nomination day

(1) The Chief Electoral Officer shall, not less than 28 clear days before polling day give public notice of that day, and shall in the notice appoint a place in Alofi and a day, being not less than 15 clear days (exclusive of polling day) before polling day, for receiving nominations of candidates.
(2) After giving any public notice, the Chief Electoral Officer shall satisfy himself that the requirements of the notice are in fact known in all constituencies concerned.

32 By-elections

(1) If the seat of a member becomes vacant 6 months or more before the
expiration of 3 years from the date of the last preceding general election, the Chief
Electoral Officer upon receipt of notice in writing from the Clerk of the Assembly
under section 30, shall forthwith, by public notice, appoint a day for a by-election
to fill the vacancy.
(2) If the seat of a member becomes vacant less than 6 months before the
expiration of 3 years from the date of the last preceding general election the seat
shall remain vacant until the next general election.
(3) Except as provided by this Act the proceedings in a by-election shall be
the same as in the case of a general election.
1264 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

33 Nomination of candidates

Nominations

(1) A person registered on an electoral roll and otherwise qualified to be a candidate at an election of members of the Assembly may with his consent be nominated in the manner prescribed in form 6, by not less than 2 other persons registered on an electoral roll and otherwise qualified to be electors at an election of members of the Assembly –
(a) Either as a candidate for election as a representative for the constituency in respect of which the nominators are registered; or
(b) As a candidate for election as a representative for the common electoral roll.
(2) (a) Every nomination paper and every consent shall be lodged with or
given to the Chief Electoral Officer not later than noon on
nomination day.
(b) The Chief Electoral Officer shall give a receipt in writing for every
nomination accepted by him.
(3) Every candidate shall be nominated by a separate nomination paper in
such manner as, in the opinion of the Chief Electoral Officer, is sufficient to identify
the candidate.
(4) No elector may nominate more than one candidate.
(5) A person registered on an electoral roll may inspect any nomination
paper or consent at the office of the Chief Electoral Officer without payment at
any time when the office is open for the transaction of business.

34 Consent to nomination

(1) No person shall consent to more than one nomination as a candidate at
any one election.
(2) Consent to the nomination of any person as a candidate shall be given
by him in form 6 and delivered to the Chief Electoral Officer but need not be
signified on the nomination paper or given at the time the nomination paper is
lodged.
(3) Where the Chief Electoral Officer has reasonable grounds to suspect
that consent has been given by any candidate who is not a resident of Niue, he
shall reject that consent and advise the candidate accordingly.
(4) If any dispute arises as to whether a candidate has or has not been in
residence in Niue that question shall be decided, after due inquiry into the facts of
the case, by the Chief Electoral Officer whose decision shall be final.

35 Deposit by candidate

(1) Every candidate or some person on his behalf, shall deposit with the
Chief Electoral Officer such sum as Cabinet may prescribe by regulation not later
than noon on nomination day.
(2) The deposit shall be paid in the form of money, a money order, a money
order telegram, or a bank draft.
(3) If the total number of votes received by any unsuccessful candidate is
less than one-fourth of the total number of votes received by the successful
candidate the deposit of the unsuccessful candidate shall be forfeited and paid
into the Niue Government Account, but in every other case the deposit shall be
returned to the person who paid it.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1265

36 Acceptance or rejection of nomination

(1) The Chief Electoral Officer shall reject the nomination of any candidate –
(a) If the nomination paper and the consent of the candidate are not
lodged with him by noon on nomination day; or
(b) If the nomination paper does not state that the candidate is
registered on a specified electoral roll; or
(c) If the nomination paper is not signed by at least 2 other persons
registered on the electoral roll in respect of which the nomination
is made; or
(d) If the required deposit is not paid as required by section 35.
(2) In every other case the Chief Electoral Officer shall accept the
nomination.
(3) Nothing in subsection (2) shall limit the jurisdiction of the Court hearing
an election petition.

37 Withdrawal of nomination

(1) (a) Every candidate at any election may sign and deliver to the Chief
Electoral Officer, not later than 7 clear days before polling day, a
paper in form 7 stating that the candidate withdraws his
nomination.
(b) The Chief Electoral Officer shall give public notice of it.
(2) No withdrawal of nomination which does not comply with subsection
(1) shall have any effect.
(3) If any candidate withdraws his nomination under subsection (1), he
shall not be capable of being elected at any poll which it may still be necessary to
hold.
(4) Where a candidate has duly withdrawn his nomination under subsection (1), his deposit shall be returned to the person who paid it.

38 Advertisement of nominations

At the hour of noon on the day appointed for the nominations of candidates,
or as soon as thereafter practicable, the Chief Electoral Officer shall cause the names
of all candidates so nominated to be posted in a conspicuous place outside the
place named in the said public notice, and shall in each constituency give public
notice of the nominations in respect of every electoral roll.

39 Insufficient number of nominations

Where at any election any vacancy remains unfilled by nominations as
aforesaid, the Chief Electoral Officer shall report accordingly to the Clerk of the
Niue Assembly who shall, not later than 3 months after nomination day, declare
the seat for which no candidate was nominated to be vacant, and thereupon section
32 shall apply.

40 Unlawful nominations

(1) Every elector who nominates more than one candidate at any election
commits an offence and is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
(2) Every person who consents to more than one nomination as a candidate
at any election or wilfully makes a false statement in his consent in respect of his
residential qualification commits an offence, and is liable to a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months.
1266 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

41 Procedure where election not contested

If only one candidate is nominated, or if any candidate who has been
nominated duly withdraws his nomination and there remains only one candidate,
the Chief Electoral Officer shall, by public notice on or before polling day, declare
that candidate to be duly elected and thereupon the Clerk of the Assembly shall,
by warrant under his hand, declare such candidate to be elected and shall publicly
notify the date of the warrant.

Contested Elections

42 If necessary, poll to be taken

If more than one candidate is nominated, and a sufficient number do not
withdraw their nominations so as to leave only one candidate, a poll for deciding
between the candidates shall be taken by secret ballot and the Chief Electoral
Officer shall forthwith give a second public notice of polling day, and public notice
of the names of the candidates.

43 Form of ballot papers

(1) Forthwith after nomination day the Chief Electoral Officer shall cause
ballot papers to be printed in form 8 in sufficient number for the election.
(2) The ballot papers shall contain a list of all the persons nominated as
candidates who have not withdrawn their nomination (each name being inserted
once only, whether nominated in one or more nomination papers), and of no other
persons, arranged alphabetically in order of their surnames in large characters;
and where 2 or more candidates have the same surname, or for any other reason
the Chief Electoral Officer considers that confusion may arise, the candidates shall
be distinguished on the ballot papers by the addition in smaller characters of their
Christian names and such other matter as may be necessary to distinguish them.
(3) The ballot papers to be used at any election shall be printed on paper
of uniform colour.
(4) Every ballot paper shall have a counterfoil in form 9.
(5) If the Returning Officer so decides, there may also be printed on the
top right-hand corner of every ballot paper and in the space provided in the
counterfoil attached to it, a number one in the case of the first ballot paper printed,
and on all succeeding ballot papers printed the numbers shall be consecutive, so
that no 2 ballot papers shall bear the same number.
(6) If a candidate withdraws his nomination after the ballot papers have
been printed the Chief Electoral Officer shall, before the poll, erase his name from
every ballot paper.

Death of Candidate

44 Death before close of nominations

(1) Where a candidate who has been nominated and has not withdrawn
his nomination dies before the close of nominations his nomination shall be treated
in all respects as if it had not been made, and his deposit shall be returned to his
personal representatives or, as the case may be, to the person who paid it.
(2) Where in any such case the candidate dies on nomination day or on the
day before nomination day the time for the close of nominations for that
constituency or for the Common Electoral Roll, as the case may be, shall be deemed
to be postponed by 2 days.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1267

45 Death after close of nominations

(1) If any candidate dies after the close of nominations and before the close
of the poll or if the successful candidate dies after the close of the poll and before
the declaration of the result of the poll, this section shall apply.
(2) The election shall be deemed to have failed and the seat shall be deemed
to be vacated.
(3) Where the candidate dies before polling day the Chief Electoral Officer
shall, upon being satisfied of the fact of the death, countermand the notice of the
poll in respect of that candidate.
(4) Where the candidate dies on polling day before the close of the poll the
Chief Electoral Officer shall, on being satisfied of the fact of the death, immediately
close the poll and declare it to be null and of no effect.
(5) Where the candidate dies after the close of the poll and before the
declaration of the result of the poll, and it is found on the completion of the count
of votes or on a recount that the candidate, if still living, would have been elected,
the Chief Electoral Officer shall, on being satisfied of the fact of the death, endorse
on the record the result of every election, the fact of the death and that the candidate,
if still living, would have been elected.
(6) The provisions of this Act as to an equality of votes between candidates
shall apply notwithstanding the death of one of those candidates after the close of
the poll.
(7) Where the poll is interrupted in consequence of the death of a candidate
all ballot papers placed in the several ballot boxes shall be taken out by the presiding
officers and, being made up into secured packages, shall be sent unopened to the
Chief Electoral Officer, who shall forthwith destroy them in the presence of an
officer appointed for the purpose by Cabinet.
(8) A fresh public notice shall be issued by the Chief Electoral Officer
forthwith for a new election and, except as otherwise provided, all proceedings in
connection with the new election shall be had and taken anew.
(9) The main roll and supplementary rolls which were to be used at the
election which has failed shall be used at the new election without any amendment
or addition.
(10) (a) It shall not be necessary to nominate afresh any candidate who at
the time of the countermand or close of the poll was a duly
nominated candidate.
(b) Any such candidate may withdraw his nomination not later than 7
clear days before the new polling day.
(11)All appointments of polling places made in respect of the election which
has failed shall continue in respect of the new election.

46 Polling places

Polling at Elections

The Chief Electoral Officer shall by public notice, given at least 7 days before polling day, appoint a sufficient number of polling places in each constituency where an election is being held for the taking of the poll.

47 Allocation of Officers

(1) The Chief Electoral Officer shall prescribe the constituency in which
Returning Officers, poll clerks, and interpreters shall exercise their functions.
(2) A Returning Officer shall have the powers and may perform any of the
duties of the Chief Electoral Officer in the constituency to which he is appointed
and shall be subject to the authority and control of the Chief Electoral Officer.
1268 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) The Chief Electoral Officer shall exercise supervision over the functions of Returning Officers, poll clerks and interpreters and may give any such officers directions as to the performance of their duties.

48 Polling booths, ballot boxes, ballot papers

The Chief Electoral Officer shall provide the following things for taking
the poll –
(a) One or more rooms for polling booths at each polling place, and in each booth one or more inner compartments, separate from but opening into the booth and having no other opening;
(b) In each inner compartment pencils for the use of the voters or other suitable facilities for the marking of ballot papers;
(c) In each booth one or more ballot boxes having a lock and key and a slit in the upper side by which the ballot papers may be put into the box;
(d) In each booth one or more copies of the main and supplementary rolls and a sufficient number of ballot papers.

49 Returning Officers, poll clerks, and interpreters

(1) The Chief Electoral Officer shall appoint for each polling booth a
Returning Officer to conduct the poll at that booth and one or more poll clerks to
assist the Returning Officer, and may appoint such additional poll clerks and such
interpreters as he considers necessary.
(2) Any Returning Officer may at any time on polling day appoint in
writing a substitute to act for him in respect of that election in case of his absence
from duty.
(3) If the Returning Officer fails to open the polling at any booth, or if he is
absent from duty and has not appointed a substitute, the poll clerk at the booth
may act for him and in that event shall be deemed to be his substitute.
(4) Every substitute while acting for any Returning Officer shall have all
the powers, duties, and functions of that Returning Officer.

50 Returning Officers, poll clerks and interpreters to make declaration

Every Returning Officer and poll clerk and interpreter shall before the poll,
and every substitute for a Returning Officer shall before acting, make a declaration
in form 10 before the Chief Electoral Officer, or another Returning Officer.

51 Scrutineers

(1) Each candidate may, by writing under his hand, appoint one scrutineer
for each polling booth at any election.
(2) Every scrutineer shall, before being allowed to act, make a declaration
in form 10 before the Chief Electoral Officer or a Returning Officer.
(3) Any scrutineer who during the hours of polling leaves the polling booth
to which he is appointed, without having first obtained the permission of the
Returning Officer at that polling booth, shall not be entitled to re-enter the booth
or to resume his scrutiny.
(4) Nothing in this Act shall render it unlawful for a scrutineer to
communicate to any person information as to the names of persons who have
voted.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1269

52 Hours of polling

(1) The poll at every election shall commence at nine o’clock in the morning
of polling day, and, except as otherwise provided in this Act, shall finally close at
6pm of the same day.
(2) Every elector who at the close of the poll is present in a booth for the
purpose of voting shall be entitled to receive a ballot paper and to mark and deposit
it in the same manner as if he had voted before the close of the poll.

53 Place of ordinary voting

Every person registered on an electoral roll unless he is a special voter,
shall be entitled to vote at any place in that constituency appointed for the taking
of the poll and at no other place.

The Ballot

54 Ballot box to be kept locked during poll

(1) The Presiding Officer shall, before the opening of the poll, and in the
sight of any of the scrutineers present, see that the ballot box is empty, and shall
close and lock it, and retain the key in his possession; and the ballot box shall not
again be opened until after the close of the poll.
(2) If the lock of a ballot box is damaged or defective so that the box cannot
be locked, the Presiding Officer shall securely seal the box instead of locking it.

55 Persons not to remain in polling booth

(1) Not more than so many voters as the Presiding Officer determines shall
be allowed in a polling booth at one and the same time, and not more than one
voter shall be allowed in any inner compartment at one and the same time.
(2) No person shall be allowed to remain in any polling booth after having
recorded his vote, except the Presiding Officer and his clerks, any of the scrutineers,
an interpreter, and as many constables as the Presiding Officer thinks necessary to
keep the peace.

56 Voters not to be spoken to in booth

(1) No scrutineers or other official or unofficial person shall speak to any
voter in a polling booth either before or after the voter has given his vote, except
only the Presiding Officer or poll clerk (with an interpreter if necessary), who
may ask the questions he is authorised to put, and give such general directions as
may assist any voter to give his vote, and in particular may on request inform a
voter orally of the names of all the candidates in alphabetical order.
(2) Every person who offends against this section commits an offence, and
is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and may be at once removed
from the booth by order of the Presiding Officer.

57 Questions may be put to voter

(1) The Presiding Officer may, and if so required by any scrutineers shall,
before allowing any person to vote, put to him the following questions –
(a) Are you the person whose name appears as A B in the electoral roll
now in force for the (Name) constituency?
(b) Are you 18 years of age or over?
(c) Are you still possessed of the qualification in respect of which you
are registered?
(d) Have you already voted at this election?
1270 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) Any person to whom these questions are put who does not answer the same, or does not answer the first 3 in the affirmative and the fourth in the negative, shall not be permitted to vote.
(3) Every person who wilfully and knowingly makes a false answer to any of the questions that the Presiding Officer may put to him under this section shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

58 Issue of ballot papers

(1) Every Presiding Officer shall, under this section, issue ballot papers to
all electors who apply to vote at the booth in respect of which he is appointed.
(2) The elector shall state his name to the Presiding Officer and shall give
such particulars as may be necessary to identify the entry in the printed rolls
relating to the elector.
(3) If the name of the elector appears in the rolls a line shall be drawn
through his name and number.
(4) If the name of the elector appears in the rolls, the Presiding Officer
shall then issue to the elector a ballot paper after he has prepared it in the following
manner –
(a) Unless a consecutive number has been printed on the ballot paper and on the counterfoil, he shall enter on both the counterfoil and the ballot paper in the spaces provided a number (called a consecutive number), beginning with the number one in the case of the first ballot paper issued by him, and on all succeeding ballot papers issued by him the numbers shall be consecutive, so that no
2 ballot papers issued in the same booth shall bear the same number; (b) He shall then fold over the corner of the ballot paper on which the consecutive number appears and shall firmly fix a piece of gummed paper over that corner so as effectively to conceal the consecutive
number;
(c) On the counterfoil of the ballot paper he shall write his initials, and
the number appearing in the roll against the name of the elector;
(d) He shall place his official booth stamp on the perforation between
the ballot paper and the counterfoil so that the booth in which the
ballot paper was issued may be identified.
(5) (a) Every Presiding Officer who fails faithfully to perform the duty
imposed on him by this section, by reason whereof any of the
requirements of this section are not effectively fulfilled, shall be
liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units;
(b) In so far as the failure relates to the duty of fixing a piece of gummed
paper over the consecutive number so as to conceal it effectively, it
shall be a sufficient defence if he satisfies the Court that he took all
reasonable precautions to secure the same.

59 Method of voting

(1) The voter, having received a ballot paper, shall immediately retire into
one of the inner compartments provided for the purpose, and shall there alone
and secretly exercise his vote by marking his ballot paper by striking out the name
of every candidate except the one for whom he wishes to vote.
(2) Every voter shall, before leaving the inner compartment, fold his ballot
paper so that the contents cannot be seen, and shall then deposit it so folded in the
ballot box.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1271

60 Spoilt ballot papers

(1) Any voter who, not having deposited his ballot paper in the ballot box,
satisfies the Presiding Officer that he has spoilt it by inadvertence may be supplied
with a fresh ballot paper, but only after the spoilt one has been returned to the
Presiding Officer.
(2) The Presiding Officer shall –
(a) Cancel every such spoilt ballot paper by writing across the face of
it the words “Spoilt by voter and a fresh ballot paper issued” and
writing his initials on it;
(b) If any ballot paper is inadvertently spoilt by the Presiding officer
or any other official, cancel it by writing across the face of it the
words “Spoilt by official” and also the words “and a fresh ballot
paper issued” if that is the case, and writing his initials on it;
(c) Retain all spoilt ballot papers in his possession until the close of the
poll.
(3) The Presiding Officer shall make up into separate packets and shall
deliver to the Chief Electoral Officer as soon as practicable after the close of the
poll all spoilt ballot papers at the polling booth at which he presided.
(4) The provisions of section 73(1) providing for the disposal of ballot
papers shall apply with respect to the disposal of spoilt ballot papers.

61 Blind or disabled voters

(1) Any elector who is wholly or partially blind, or is unable to read or
write (whether because of physical handicap or otherwise), may vote under this
section.
(2) At the request of any such voter who has received a ballot paper the
Presiding Officer shall accompany him into one of the inner compartments
provided for the marking of ballot papers, and the ballot paper may there be
marked by the voter with the assistance of the Presiding Officer or may be marked
by the Presiding Officer under the instructions of the voter.
(3) The person assisting the voter shall sign his name on the back of the
ballot paper and shall add the words “Witness for blind or partially blind person”
or “Witness for person unable to read or write”, as the case may be, and shall fold
the ballot paper so that its face cannot be seen before depositing it in the ballot
box.
(4) A poll clerk or some other person nominated by the voter shall also accompany him into the inner compartment and may, if so desired by the voter, inspect the ballot paper before it is deposited in the ballot box.
(5) Any elector voting as a special voter may vote in the manner prescribed by this section, with any necessary modifications, or in any manner prescribed by regulations made under this Act.
(6) If any elector is precluded by reason of illness or infirmity from attending at any polling booth, the Presiding Officer shall make such arrangements as are in his opinion reasonably practicable to enable the voter, if he so desires, to vote.
(7) Every person who is present under this section or with any regulations when an elector votes and who communicates at any time to any person any information obtained as to the candidate for whom the voter is about to vote or has voted, or as to the number on the ballot paper given to the voter commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
3 months.
1272 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

62 Procedure when second vote given in same name

(1) If any person representing himself to be a voter at any election gives as
his name the name of any person to whom a ballot paper has already been given
at the same election, the voter shall, upon giving satisfactory answers to any
questions put to him by the Presiding Officer, be entitled to receive a ballot paper
in the same manner as any other voter, but that ballot paper (hereinafter referred
to as a tendered ballot paper), instead of being put into the ballot box, shall be
given to the presiding officer who shall place it in an envelope, seal the envelope
and then endorse the envelope with the name of the voter and his number in the
electoral roll.
(2) (a) The name of the voter and his number in the electoral roll shall be
entered by the Presiding Officer on a list to be called the tendered
votes list, and that list shall be admissible as evidence in any legal
proceedings arising out of the election.
(b) The tendered votes list shall be in form 11.
(3) The envelope containing the tendered ballot paper shall be placed by
the Presiding Officer in the ballot box but shall not be counted.

63 Voting by special voters

Special Voting

(1) Any registered elector may vote as a special voter if, on polling day, he will not be in the constituency of which he is a resident.
(2) Any such elector who desires to vote as a special voter shall, not later than 7 days before polling day, apply to the Chief Electoral Officer for a certificate enabling the applicant to vote in the constituency in which he will be present on polling day, and the Chief Electoral officer if satisfied that the application is made in good faith shall issue the certificate in form 12.
(3) On polling day, on delivery by the special voter of the certificate issued to him as aforesaid, the Presiding Officer at the place named in the certificate shall supply the special voter with a ballot paper containing the names of the candidates nominated for election.
(4) Subject to this section, all the provision of this Part shall, as far as
applicable and with the necessary modifications, apply with respect to voting by
special voters and to their votes.
(5) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Part, the consecutive
number of special ballot papers in any polling booth shall be in a different series
from that used in that booth for ordinary voting.

64 Voting in advance of poll

(1) Any registered elector who is entitled to vote as a special voter may
instead of applying for a certificate under section 63(2) vote in advance of polling
day.
(2) Application for leave to vote in advance shall be made to the Chief Electoral Officer at any time during office hours not earlier than 3 working days after nomination day and not later than the day immediately preceding the day fixed for taking the poll.
(3) Every applicant shall sign and deliver to the Chief Electoral Officer a
declaration in form 13 and the Chief Electoral Officer, if satisfied that the application
is made in good faith, shall issue to the applicant –
(a) A ballot paper; and
(b) An envelope marked “Vote in Advance of Poll” and addressed to
the Returning Officer in charge of the constituency.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1273
(4) (a) Before giving the ballot paper to the applicant, the Chief Electoral
Officer shall proceed as provided in section 58;
(b) He shall also enter the date of voting in advance on the counterfoil
and the top right-hand corner of the back of the ballot paper, and
also against the name of the applicant on the master roll.
(5) The applicant shall then alone and secretly on the ballot paper indicate
the candidate for whom he desires to vote, place the ballot paper duly folded in
the envelope, and deliver the envelope, after sealing it, to the Chief Electoral Officer.
(6) The Chief Electoral Officer shall hold for production on polling day
the sealed envelope, together with the declaration form on which the consecutive
number shall be entered, and shall be personally responsible for their safe custody.
(7) (a) On polling day the Chief Electoral Officer shall deliver the sealed
envelopes to the Presiding Officers in charge of each of the polling
booths where votes have been made in advance of the poll.
(b) The Presiding Officer shall give a receipt to the Chief Electoral officer
for the envelopes and shall record the number of envelopes received
by him on the form provided for this purpose.
(8) The Presiding Officer shall during the hours of polling open all the
envelopes delivered to him, extract from it any ballot papers and deposit the ballot
papers, without unfolding them, in the ballot box.
(9) Any person who, with intent to offer to exercise more votes than are
lawfully permitted at the same election, after having applied for a certificate
enabling him to vote as a special voter under section 63, applies for leave to vote
in advance of poling day, or, after having voted in advance of polling day, applies
for a certificate as a special voter, commits an offence and is liable to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 3 months.

Preliminary Count of Votes

65 Procedure after close of poll

(1) At each polling booth the Presiding Officer shall, as soon as practicable
after the close of the poll, in the presence of such of the scrutineers as
choose to be present, and the poll clerks, but of no other person, perform the
following duties –
(a) He shall make up into separate parcels –
(i) the certified copies of the main roll and supplementary rolls
on which the fact of any person having received a ballot paper
has been noted; and
(ii) all the counterfoils of ballot papers that have been issued to
voters; and
(iii) all the spoilt ballot papers; and
(iv) all the unused ballot papers.
(b) He shall then open the ballot boxes and, taking therefrom all the
ballot papers in it, proceed to ascertain the number of votes received
by each candidate;
(c) He shall set aside as informal all ballot papers which do not clearly
indicate the candidate for whom the voter desired to vote;
(d) He shall announce the result of the voting at the polling booth at
which he presides and arrange for the result of the voting to be
transmitted as soon as possible to the Chief Electoral Officer;
1274 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(e) He shall make up into separate parcels –
(i) the used ballot papers, together with (but in separate
enclosures) the ballot papers set aside as informal, and the ballot
papers set aside under section 62; and
(ii) a certificate signed by himself and by such of the scrutineers as
are present and consent to sign it of the number of votes
received by each candidate; the number of ballot papers set
aside as informal, the number of ballot papers set aside under
section 62; the number of spoilt ballot papers, the number of
ballot papers delivered to special voters, the number of unused
ballot papers, and the number of ballot papers originally
delivered to him.
(2) Each parcel made up under this section shall be endorsed by the
Presiding Officer with a description of its contents, the name of the constituency,
the name of the polling place, the number of the booth and the date of the polling;
and the endorsement shall be signed by the Presiding Officer and by such of the
scrutineers as are present and desire to sign it; and the parcel shall be enclosed in
paper or similar material and shall be properly secured.
(3) The Presiding Officer shall forthwith forward all the parcels mentioned
in this section to the Chief Electoral Officer.

66 Scrutiny of the rolls

Scrutiny of the Rolls

(1) The Chief Electoral Officer shall make arrangements for a scrutiny of the rolls as soon as practicable after the close of the poll, and shall give notice in writing to each of the candidates or their scrutineers of the time and place at which he will commence the scrutiny.
(2) No person other than the Chief Electoral Officer and his assistants, and one person appointed as scrutineer by each candidate for the purpose, shall be present at the scrutiny.
(3) No candidate shall act as scrutineer under this section.

67 Marked copies of rolls to be compared

(1) The Chief Electoral Officer shall, in the presence and hearing of his
assistants (if any) and such scrutineers as are entitled to be present under this Act,
but of no other person, compare one with another all the certified copies of the
main roll and the supplementary rolls on which the fact of any person having
received a ballot paper has been noted and all records of special votes exercised,
and shall on an unmarked copy of the main roll and every supplementary roll
(called the master roll) draw a line through the number and name of any elector
who is shown on any of the certified copies of the rolls or in any record of special
votes issued as having received a ballot paper.
(2) (a) If on that comparison, or from the checking of declarations in respect
of special votes, or from the report of the Presiding Officer on the
ballot papers set aside under section 62 and after such inquiry as
the Chief Electoral Officer deems necessary, it appears that the same
voter has received more ballot paper than lawfully ballot paper,
the Chief Electoral Officer shall, in the presence of his assistants (if
any) and such scrutineers as choose to be present, but of no other
person, open the parcel or parcels of ballot papers used at the polling
booth or polling booths at which that voter appears to have received
a ballot paper, and shall select from it the ballot papers which appear

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1275
from their consecutive numbers and counterfoils to have been issued to that voter, and shall disallow every vote appearing to have been given by means of the ballot papers so selected.
(b) If the Chief Electoral Officer is satisfied that the ballot papers were lawfully received by the voter entitled to it the Chief Electoral Officer shall allow those votes to which the voter is entitled.
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2), every ballot paper issued to a special voter shall be deemed to have been issued at a polling booth.
(4) Except in the case of the ballot papers so selected therefrom, the Chief
Electoral Officer shall inspect only the consecutive numbers on the ballot papers
in the several parcels so opened, and shall so cover the ballot papers that no person
present shall have the opportunity of determining the candidate for whom any
particular voter has voted.

68 Parcels to be secured after scrutiny

(1) When the Chief Electoral Officer has selected from any parcel all the
ballot papers he is required to select therefrom, he shall forthwith in the presence
of his assistants (if any) and such scrutineers as are present, but of no other person
close and secure the parcel, and shall endorse on it a memorandum of the fact of
the ballot papers having been selected from that parcel, specifying the same by
the name of the person to whom the same appear to have been delivered, and
shall sign the endorsement with his name.
(2) The Chief Electoral Officer shall set aside all ballot papers selected by
him from any parcel as herein provided, and shall in the presence of his assistants
(if any) and such scrutineers as are present, but of no other person, secure those
ballot papers in a separate parcel and shall endorse the parcel with a description
of the contents of it and shall sign the endorsement with his name.

Official Count and Declaration of Poll

69 Counting the votes

(1) (a) On completion of the scrutiny hereinbefore directed the Chief
Electoral Officer, with such assistants as he deems necessary, and
in the presence of such of the scrutineers appointed under section
66 as are present, but of no other person, shall select and open one
of the parcels of used ballot papers referred to in section 65 (1)(e)
and shall mark each ballot paper in it with a number in consecutive
order, beginning with the number one, so that no 2 ballot papers in
that parcel shall bear the same number.
(b) The procedure set out in this subsection need not be delayed until
the inquiries under section 66(2) have been completed, but the ballot
papers from any particular polling booth shall not be counted until
any inquiries in respect of ballot papers from that booth have been
completed.
(2) When the ballot papers from the parcel so selected have been marked
as aforesaid the Chief Electoral Officer shall make a record of the last number
marked, and shall then, in the presence of his assistants (if any) and the scrutineers
as aforesaid, but of no other person, deal with the ballot papers as follows –
(a) (i) He shall reject as informal any ballot paper –
(I) That does not bear the official mark if there is reasonable
cause to believe that it was not issued to a voter by any
Presiding Officer; or
1276

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(II) That purports to vote for more candidates than the number of candidates elected; or
(III) That has anything not authorised by this Act written or marked on it which the elector can be identified; or
(IV) That does not clearly indicate the candidate for whom the voter desired to vote;
(ii) no ballot paper shall be rejected as informal by reason only of some informality in the manner in which it has been dealt with by the voter if it is otherwise regular, and if in the opinion of the Chief Electoral Officer the intention of the voter in voting is clearly indicated;
(ii) no ballot paper shall be rejected as informal by reason only of
some error or omission on the part of an official, if the Chief
Electoral Officer is satisfied that the voter was qualified to vote
at the election;
(b) The Chief Electoral Officer shall then count the number of votes
received by each candidate, and the number of votes rejected as
informal, and compare the result of that count with the certificate
of the Presiding Officer in respect of the preliminary count, and
shall, where necessary, amend that certificate; and every such
certificate shall be initialled by the Chief Electoral Officer;
(c) The Chief Electoral Officer shall then make up and secure the parcel
anew, and endorse on it a memorandum specifying the number of
ballot papers contained in the parcel, the number of votes received
by each candidate, the number of informal ballot papers, and the
number of the booth at which the votes were recorded; and the
endorsement shall be signed by the Chief Electoral Officer.
(3) After the ballot papers from one parcel have been dealt with in the
manner aforesaid, those from the remaining parcels shall be successively dealt
with in like manner, the marking of the ballot papers to commence with the number
one in the case of each parcel.
(4) The ballot papers of special voters shall be dealt with in like manner,
after which they shall be made up together into a parcel which shall be properly
secured and shall be endorsed in the manner described in this section.

70 Declaration of result of poll

(1) When all the ballot papers have been dealt with as aforesaid the Chief
Electoral Officer, having ascertained the total number of votes received by each candidate, shall declare the result of the poll by giving public notice of it in form
14.
(2) Where there is an equality of votes between candidates and the addition of a vote would entitle one of those candidates to be declared elected, the Chief Electoral Officer shall forthwith apply to a Judge of the High Court for a recount under section 71 and that section shall apply accordingly, except that no deposit shall be necessary.
(3) In any case where on any recount under section 71 there is an equality of votes between candidates and the addition of a vote would entitle one of those candidates to be declared elected, the Chief Electoral Officer shall determine by lot which candidate shall be elected.
(4) The Chief Electoral Officer shall report the result of every election to
the Clerk of the Assembly who shall by warrant under his hand declare the
successful candidate to be elected and shall publicly notify the date of the warrant.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1277

Recount

71 Application to Judge for recount

(1) Where any candidate has reason to believe that the public declaration
by the Chief Electoral Officer of the number of votes received by each candidate is
incorrect, and that on a recount of it the first-mentioned candidate might be found
to be elected, he may within 3 days after the public declaration apply to a Judge
for a recount of the votes.
(2) Every such application shall be accompanied by a deposit of such sum
as Cabinet may prescribe by regulation.
(3) The Judge shall cause a recount of the votes to be commenced within 3
days after receiving the application, and shall give notice in writing to the Chief
Electoral Officer and to each of the candidates or their scrutineers of the time and
place at which the recount will be made.
(4) (a) The recount shall be made in the presence of the Judge or of an
officer appointed by him for the purpose, and shall as far as
practicable be made in the manner provided in the case of the
original count;
(b) No person shall be present at the recount except the Judge or the
officer appointed by him, his assistants (if any), the Chief Electoral
Officer and his assistants (if any) and the scrutineers appointed
under section 66.
(5) The Judge shall have all the powers that the Chief Electoral Officer had
on the original count, and may reverse any decision made by the Chief Electoral
Officer in the exercise of those powers.
(6) If on the recount the Judge finds that the public declaration was incorrect
he shall order the Chief Electoral Officer to give an amended declaration of the
result of the poll.
(7) The Judge may make such order as to the costs of and incidental to the
recount as he deems just, and, subject to any such order, shall direct the deposit
made under this section to be returned to the person who paid it.

72 Ballot papers and certificate to be compared on recount

(1) At any recount made as aforesaid the Chief Electoral Office shall
produce to the Judge all the used ballot papers, together with the certificate stating
the total number of ballot papers used at the election.
(2) (a) If on comparing the number of ballot papers stated in the certificate
with the ballot papers used at the election the Judge finds that any
of the ballot papers have been lost, stolen, or in any way interfered
with during the interval between the official count and the recount,
the official count made by the Chief Electoral Officer shall be deemed
to be correct, and the result of the poll declared accordingly.
(b) Where in any such case there is an equality of votes between
candidates and the addition of a vote would entitle one of those
candidates to be declared elected, the Chief Electoral Officer shall
determine by lot which candidate shall be elected.

Disposal of Ballot Papers

73 Disposal of ballot papers, rolls

(1) As soon as practicable after polling day the Chief Electoral Officer shall
enclose in separate packets in the following manner all the parcels transmitted to
him by the several Presiding Officers or made up and secured by himself –
1278 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) He shall enclose in one or more separate packets all the parcels of used ballot papers, including the special voters’ ballot papers and all counterfoils corresponding to those ballot papers; in one or more other separate packets all parcels of unused and spoilt ballot papers; in another all parcels of ballot papers set aside under sections 62 and 68 and in one or more other separate packets all parcels containing ballot paper accounts, copies of rolls (except the master roll), books, or other papers, as in this Act provided, and all letters, and other papers received from any Chief Electoral Officer in respect of the votes of special voters;
(b) He shall properly secure the said several packets, and endorse them with a description of the contents of it respectively; and the name of the constituency and the date of the polling, and shall sign the endorsement; and shall forthwith forward the said packets to the Registrar of the High Court;
(c) He shall also at the same time properly secure and transmit to the Registrar of the Court a parcel containing all ballot papers printed for the election and not used by the Chief Electoral Officer or distributed for use to any Presiding Officer.
(2) The Registrar of the Court shall forthwith give or send to the Chief
Electoral Officer a receipt under his hand for the said packets and parcel.
(3) The Chief Electoral Officer shall send the master roll to the Registrar of
Electors and the Registrar shall keep it until the next general election.
(4) Any registered elector of the constituency may inspect any master roll
at the Registrar ’s office without payment of any fee at any time when the office is
open for the transaction of business.

74 Disposal of packets

(1) The packets and parcel shall be safely kept for one year unopened,
unless the Court orders them, or any of them, to be opened.
(2) At the end of one year the packets and parcel shall be destroyed
unopened in the presence of the Clerk of the Assembly and the Registrar of the
Court.

75 Papers taken from parcels as evidence in certain cases

(1) Any ballot paper and any copy of a roll, and any book purporting to be
taken from any such parcel as aforesaid, and having written on it respectively,
under the hand of the Registrar of the Court a certificate of the several particulars
by this Act required to be endorsed on the parcel shall be conclusive evidence in
any Court that it was so taken and that it, if a ballot paper, was deposited and, if a
roll or book, was kept or used at the election and booth to which the endorsement
and writing relate.
(2) Every ballot paper so certified shall be evidence of a vote given at the
poll, and of the correspondence of the number appearing on the ballot paper with
the number appearing on any roll so certified as of the same election and booth,
according to the tenor of the said ballot paper.
(3) But in the case of the ballot papers set aside or selected by a Presiding
Officer or by the Chief Electoral Officer, the correspondence shall be evidence
only of some person having voted in the name appearing on the roll.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1279

Maintenance of Order at Elections

76 Presiding Officer to maintain order

Every Presiding Officer shall have power to enforce order and keep the
peace at any election and may, without any other warrant than this Act, cause to
be arrested and taken before a Judge or Commissioner of the High Court any
person reasonably suspected of knowingly and wilfully making a false answer to
any of the questions the Presiding Officer is authorised to put, or who attempts to
personate any voter or to vote more than once at the same election, or who obstructs
the approaches to any polling booth, or who otherwise behaves in a disorderly
manner or causes disturbances at any election; and all constables shall aid and
assist the Presiding Officer in the performance of his duty.

77 Adjournment of poll

(1) Where the polling at any polling place cannot start or has to be
suspended whether by reason of riot or open violence, natural disaster, or any
other cause, the Presiding Officer shall adjourn the taking of the poll at that polling
place to the following day, and if necessary from day to day until the poll can be
taken, and shall forthwith give public notice of the adjournment in such manner
as he thinks fit.
(2) The poll shall not be kept open for more than 9 hours in all at any
polling place.

Custody of Ballot Papers

78 Prevention of irregularities

In order to prevent the commission at any election of irregularities in respect
of the improper possession of ballot papers the following shall apply –
(a) The Chief Electoral Officer shall give to the person printing the ballot
papers a receipt specifying the total number of ballot papers received
by him, and it shall be the duty of the printer to see that all copies
of the ballot paper other than those delivered to the Chief Electoral
Officer are immediately destroyed;
(b) Every Presiding Officer shall give to the Chief Electoral Officer a
receipt specifying the total number of ballot papers received by him,
and shall be personally responsible for the safe custody of all such
ballot papers from the time they are received by him until they are
issued or otherwise disposed of under this Act;
(c) Every Presiding officer shall be personally responsible for the safe
custody of all ballot papers used at the polling booth at which he
presides from the time each ballot paper was placed in the ballot
box by the voter until the parcel of used ballot papers has been
delivered to the Chief Electoral Officer as in this Act provided and
the Presiding officer obtained from the Chief Electoral officer a
receipt in writing for the parcel, which receipt the Chief Electoral
Officer is in all cases required to give on such delivery;
(d) In like manner the Chief Electoral Officer shall be personally
responsible for the safe custody of all ballot papers used at the
polling booth at which he presides until they have been sent to the
Registrar of the Court as hereinbefore provided, and also for the
safe custody of all parcels of used ballot papers for which he has
given a receipt to a Presiding Officer, until they have been sent by
him to the Registrar of the Court as aforesaid;
1280

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(e) Every person who fails to take reasonable steps to secure the safe custody of all ballot papers for which he is responsible, with the result that any such ballot paper is removed from his custody, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months;
(f) Every person shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit
who wilfully or negligently allows any copy of a ballot paper printed
by him to come into the possession of any person other than the
Chief Electoral Officer;
(g) Every person shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit
who except under any regulations made under this Act in relation
to special voters, obtains possession of or has in his possession any
ballot paper other than the one given to him by the Chief Electoral
Officer or Presiding Officer for the purpose of recording his vote,
or retains any ballot paper in his possession after leaving the polling
booth.

79 Interfering with voters

Offences at Elections

(1) Every person commits an offence and shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units who at an election –
(a) In any way interferes with any elector, either in the polling booth or while on his way to it, with the intention of influencing him or advising him as to his vote;
(b) At any time on polling day before the close of the poll in or in view or hearing of any public place holds or takes part in any demonstration or procession having direct or indirect reference to the poll by any means whatsoever;
(c) At any time on polling day before the close of the poll makes any
statement having direct or indirect reference to the poll by means
of any loudspeaker or public address apparatus or cinematograph
apparatus;
(d) At any time on polling day before the close of the poll, or at any
time on any of the 3 days immediately preceding polling day, prints
or distributes or delivers to any person anything being or purporting
to be in imitation of any ballot paper to be used at the poll and
having on it the names of the candidates or any of them, together
with any direction or indication as to the candidate for whom any
person should vote, or in any way containing any such direction or
indication, or having on it any matter likely to influence any vote;
(e) At any time on polling day before the close of the poll exhibits in or
in view of any public place, or publishes or distributes, or
broadcasts, any statement advising or intended or likely to influence
any elector as to the candidate or party for whom he should vote:
Provided that this paragraph shall not apply to any statement in a
newspaper published before six o’clock in the afternoon of the day
before polling day:
Provided also that where any statement is so exhibited before
pooling day in a fixed position not in view of a polling place it shall
not be an offence to leave it so exhibited on polling day:
Provided further that the Chief Electoral Officer may at any time
on polling day cause to be removed or obliterated any statement to

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1281
which this paragraph applies which is exhibited within half a mile of a polling place, and may recover all expenses incurred in so doing from the persons by whom or by whose direction the statement was exhibited, as a debt due by them jointly and severally to the Government;
(f) At any time on polling day before the close of the poll prints or
distributes or delivers to any person any card or paper (whether or
not it is an imitation ballot paper) having on it the names of the
candidates or any of them;
(g) Exhibits or leaves in any polling booth any card or paper having
thereon any direction or indication as to how any persons should
vote or as to the method of voting;
(h) At any time on polling day before the close of the poll, within, or at
the entrance to, or in the vicinity of, any polling place –
(i) gives or offers to give to any person any written or oral
information as to any name or number of the main roll or any
supplementary roll being used at the election;
(ii) permits or offers to permit any person to examine any copy of
the main roll or any supplementary roll being used at the
election.
(2) It shall not be an offence against this section for any person to wear or
display (whether on his person or not) any party emblem.
(3) Nothing in this section shall apply to any official statement or
announcement made or exhibited under the authority of this Act.

80 Publishing defamatory matter at election time

Every person shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit or to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months who at any time after public
notice has been given of any election and before the close of the poll publishes or
exposes, or causes to be published or exposed, to public view any document or
writing or printed matter containing any untrue statement defamatory of any
candidate and calculated to influence the vote of any elector.

81 Erasing and altering official mark

Every person shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit who
erases, obliterates, or alters any official mark, stamp, or writing on any ballot paper,
or places on it any writing, print, or other matter which might lead persons to
believe that it was put on it by any official or person duly authorised in that behalf.

82 Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence against this section who –
(a) Forges, or counterfeits, or fraudulently defaces, or fraudulently
destroys any ballot paper, or the official mark on any ballot paper;
(b) Without due authority supplies any ballot paper to any person;
(c) Fraudulently puts into any ballot box any paper other than the ballot
paper that he is authorised by law to put in there;
(d) Fraudulently takes out of a polling booth any ballot paper;
(e) Without due authority destroys, takes, opens, or otherwise interferes
with any ballot box, or box or packet or parcel of ballot papers,
then in use for the purposes of an election, or in course of
transmission by post or otherwise, or thereafter whenever the same
may be kept as a record of the election.
1282 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this section shall be liable on conviction –
(a) If an officer appointed under this Act to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years;
(b) If any other person, to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months.
(3) Every person who attempts to commit any offence against this section shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one half of the longest term to which a person committing the offence may be sentenced.

83 Property in Chief Electoral Officer

In any prosecution for an offence in relation to any ballot boxes, ballot
papers, or making instruments at an election, the property in the boxes, papers,
and instruments may be stated as being in the Chief Electoral Officer.

84 Infringement of secrecy

(1) Every official, clerk, scrutineer, interpreter, and constable in attendance
at a polling booth shall maintain and aid in maintaining the secrecy of the voting
in the booth, and shall not communicate to any person, except for some purpose
authorised by law, any information likely to defeat the secrecy of the ballot.
(2) No person, except for some purpose authorised by law, shall –
(a) Interfere with or attempt to interfere with a voter when marking
his vote;
(b) Attempt to obtain in a polling booth information as to the candidate
for whom any voter in a booth is about to vote or has voted;
(c) Communicate at any time to any person any information obtained
in a polling booth as to the candidate for whom any voter at the
booth is about to vote or has voted, or as to the consecutive number
on the ballot paper given to any voter at the booth.
(3) Every person in attendance at the counting of the votes shall maintain
and aid in maintaining the secrecy of the voting, and shall not communicate any
information obtained at the counting as to the candidate for whom any vote is
given in any particular ballot paper.
(4) No person shall directly or indirectly induce any voter to display his
ballot paper after he has marked it, so as to make known to any person the name
of any candidate for or against whom he has voted.
(5) Every person who offends against this section shall be liable to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months.

85 Corrupt practices

PART 4
CORRUPT PRACTICES
Every person is guilty of a corrupt practice, and is liable to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year, who, in connection with any election, is convicted of bribery, treating, undue influence, or personation as defined in this Part.

86 Bribery

Every person commits the offence of bribery who, in connection with any
election –
(a) Directly or indirectly gives or offers to give to any elector any money or valuable consideration or any office or employment in order to induce the elector to vote or refrain from voting; or

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1283
(b) Directly or indirectly makes any gift or offer as aforesaid to any person in order to induce that person to procure or endeavour to procure the return of any candidate or the vote of any elector; or
(c) Upon or in consequence of any such gift or offer, procures or endeavours to procure the return of any candidate or the vote of any elector; or
(d) Advances any money to any person with the intent that that money or any part of it shall be expended in bribery within the meaning of this section; or
(e) Being an elector, directly or indirectly receives or agrees to receive any gift, money, valuable consideration, office, or employment as aforesaid in return for voting or refraining from voting or for agreeing to it.

87 Treating

Every person commits the offence of treating who, being a candidate at
any election, by himself or any other person on his behalf, corruptly gives or
provides any meat, drink, entertainment, or other provision to or for any person
for the purpose of procuring his own election or on account of his having been
elected or for any other purpose calculated to influence the vote of that person.

88 Undue influence

Every person commits the offence of undue influence who, by himself or
any other person on his behalf, uses or threatens to use any force, violence or
restraint, or inflicts or threatens to inflict any injury, damage, harm, or loss upon
or against any person in order to induce or compel that person to vote or refrain
from voting or on account of that person having voted or refrained from voting,
or who by abduction, duress, or any fraudulent device or contrivance in any way
interferes with the free exercise of the franchise by an elector.

89 Personation

Every person commits the offence of personation who at any election applies
for a voting paper in the name of some other person, living or dead, or of a fictitious
person, or who, having voted once at any such election, applies again at the same
election for a voting paper in his own name.

90 Election petitions

PART 5
DISPUTED ELECTIONS
(1) Where any candidate and 5 electors, or where any 10 electors, are dissatisfied with the result of any election held in respect of which that candidate is nominated, or in which those electors are registered, they may, within 14 days after the declaration of the result of the election, by petition filed in the High Court as hereinafter mentioned, demand an inquiry as to the conduct of the election or of any candidate or other person at it.
(2) Every such petition shall be accompanied by a deposit of $20.
(3) The petition shall be in form 15 and shall be filed in the Court, and
shall be heard and determined before a Judge of the Court.
(4) The petition shall allege the specific grounds on which the complaint is
founded, and no grounds other than those stated shall be investigated except by
leave of the Judge and upon reasonable notice being given, which leave may be
given on such terms and conditions as the Judge deems just.
1284 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(5) Evidence may be given to prove that the election of any rejected candidate would be invalid in the same manner as if the petition had complained of his election.

91 Candidate may oppose petition

Any candidate may, at any time before the commencement of the inquiry,
file in the Court a notice in writing of his intention to oppose the petition, and
thereupon the candidate shall be deemed to be the respondent to the petition.

92 Time for holding inquiry

The inquiry shall be commenced within 14 days after the filing of the
petition, but not earlier than 14 days after the day on which the poll was closed,
and not less than 7 days’ public notice shall be given of the time and place at
which the inquiry will be held.

93 Powers of Judge on inquiry

For the purposes of the inquiry, the Judge shall have and may exercise all
the powers of citing parties, compelling evidence, adjourning from time to time
and from place to place, and maintaining order that he would have in this ordinary
jurisdiction, and, in addition, may at any time during the inquiry direct a recount
or scrutiny of the votes given at the election, and shall disallow the vote of every
person who –
(a) Has voted, not being entitled to vote; or
(b) Has given more votes than he was entitled to give.

94 Certain irregularities

No election shall be declared void by reason of any irregularity in any of
the proceedings preliminary to the polling or by reason of any failure to hold a
poll at any place appointed for holding a poll, or to comply with the directions
contained or incorporated in this Act as to the taking of the poll or the counting of
the votes or by reason of any mistake in the use of the forms contained or
incorporated in this Act, if it appears to be the Judge that the election was conducted
under the principles laid down in and by this Act and that the irregularity, failure,
or mistake did not affect the result of the election.

95 Result of inquiry

(1) The Judge shall determine whether, by reason of some irregularity that
in his opinion materially affected the result of the election, the election is void; or
whether the candidate whose election is complained of, or any and what other
candidate, was duly elected.
(2) The Judge shall cause any determination under this section to be
transmitted to the Clerk of the Assembly, who shall forthwith –
(a) Publicly notify any such determination;
(b) Where any election is determined to be void, declare the seat vacant
under section 10;
(c) Where any other candidate is determined to be elected, declare that
candidate to be elected under section 70 and revoke any warrant
previously issued by him under that section which is not consistent
with the determination.

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1285

96 Persons committing irregularities to be prosecuted

Where on any such inquiry the Judge is of the opinion that any irregularity
has been wilfully committed by any person, he shall direct the officer in charge of
the Police to take proceedings for the prosecution of that person, who on conviction
shall (unless some other penalty is elsewhere prescribed) be liable –
(a) To a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units where the irregularity, in the
opinion of the Judge, materially affected the result of the election;
or
(b) To a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units, where the irregularity did
not, in the opinion of the Judge, materially affect the result but
defeated the fairness of the election; or
(c) To a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units, where the irregularity did
not, in the opinion of the Judge, either materially affect the result or
defeat the fairness of the election.

97 Costs of inquiry

(1) (a) The Judge may order that the expenses of and incidental to the
inquiry shall be borne either by any party to the inquiry, or, where
he declares the election void on the ground or partly on the ground
of any negligence or misfeasance of any electoral officer or other
person exercising any functions at the election under this Act, may
order that those expenses or any part of it shall be borne by that
officer or other person; and that order shall have the same effect
and may be enforced in like manner as it if were a judgment for a
sum of money obtained in the Court;
(b) No such order shall be made against any person other than a party
to the inquiry, unless he has been summoned to attend and give
evidence at the inquiry.
(2) Subject to any such order, the Judge shall direct that the deposit
accompanying any petition shall be returned to the person or persons who paid
the same, unless the Judge is of opinion that the petitioners have failed to establish
the grounds specified in their petition, or any other grounds investigated by leave
of the Judge, in which case the deposit or the surplus remaining after satisfying
the order shall be deemed to be forfeited to Her Majesty, and shall form part of the
public revenue of Niue.

98 Determination by Court final

Every determination or order by the Judge in respect of or in connection
with an election petition shall be final.
PART 6
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

99 Notification of bankruptcy and death

(1) The Registrar of the Court shall forthwith after adjudication as a
bankrupt of a member, or after his conviction of an offence under section 102(2) or
of any offence described in section 12(1)(e) notify the fact to the Clerk of the
Assembly.
(2) The Registrar of Births and Deaths by whom the death of any member
is registered shall, within one working day of making that registration, notify the
fact to the Clerk of the Assembly.
1286 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

100 Printing and forms

(1) Any requirement of printing under this Act shall be satisfied by
typewriting and any mechanical process of reproducing typewritten copies, and
the term “printed” shall, where necessary, be construed accordingly.
(2) Where any form prescribed by or referred to in this Act is not available,
a form may be improvised, and any electoral officer using or issuing any such
form improvised shall affix his initials or official mark to it.

101 Form and transmission of documents

(1) Every person making or giving any claim, application, declaration, or
notice under this Act shall sign the same with his own hand, or, if he cannot write,
his mark shall be attested by a Postmaster, an officer of the Court, or any electoral
officer.
(2) Save as otherwise provided in this Act, every such document may be delivered to any electoral officer appointed in any constituency for the purposes of this Act who shall transmit it to the Chief Electoral Officer, the Court, or the appropriate electoral officer, as the case may be, by mail or telegram as circumstances require, and the expenses of any such transmission of any such bona fide document shall be paid out of the pubic revenues of Niue.

102 Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence and is liable to a fine not exceeding
0.5 penalty units, who –
(a) Procures himself to be nominated as a candidate for election as a
member knowing himself to be incapable under any provisions of
this Act holding that office; or
(b) Signs any nomination paper purporting to nominate to that office
a person who is, to the knowledge of the person so signing,
incapable as aforesaid; or
(c) Signs any nomination paper knowing himself not to be qualified to
nominate a candidate.
(2) Every member who sits or votes in the Assembly, being disqualified
under any provisions of this Act and knowing himself to be so disqualified, or
being liable to have his seat declared vacant under any provisions of this Act and
knowing himself to be so liable, commits an offence and is liable to a fine not
exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day on which he so sits or votes.

103 General penalty for offences

(1) Every person appointed to carry the provisions of this Act into execution
commits an offence, and is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit or to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding one month who is guilty of any wilful or
negligent act of commission or omission contrary to this Act in respect of any
election, and for which no other penalty is provided by this Act.
(2) Any other person who commits a breach of this Act for which no other
penalty is provided by this Act is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

104 Validation of irregularities

Where anything is omitted to be done or cannot be done at the time required
by or under this Act, or is done before or after that time, or is otherwise irregularly
done in matter of form, or sufficient provision is not made by or under this Act,
the Chief Electoral Officer may, by public notice, at any time before or after the
time within which the thing is required to be done, extend that time, or validate

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1287
anything so done before or after the time required or so irregularly done in matter of form or make other provision for the case as he thinks fit.

105 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make such regulations as may be deemed necessary or
expedient for the purpose of giving full effect to this Act and for the due
administration of it.
(2) Regulations made under this section may prescribe penalties for
offences against the regulations, not exceeding imprisonment for a term of 3 months
or a fine of 1 penalty unit, or both.
(3) Any regulations made under this section shall be laid before the
Assembly within 14 days after the date of the making of it if the Assembly is then
in session, or if not, within 14 days after the commencement of the next ensuing
session.
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
Form 1
APPLICATION FOR REGISTRATION AS AN ELECTOR
I hereby claim to have my name entered upon the Electoral Roll for the Constituency, and I declare that the answers to the following questions are true and correct in every particular:
1 (a) Your full name:
.................................................................................................................................

(Surname) (First Name) (Middle Name)

(b) Your father ’s name:
.................................................................................................................................

(Surname) (First Name) (Middle Name)

(c) Your husband’s/wife’s name:
.................................................................................................................................

(Surname) (First Name) (Middle Name)

2. Your present occupation: ...........................................................................................
3. Your present residential address: ..............................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................
4. Have you resided in Niue throughout the period of 12 months immediately before the making of this application?
.......................................................................................................................................
1288 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
5. Have you lived at your present address throughout that 12 month period?
.......................................................................................................................................
6. If not, list the addresses, with the length of time, at which you have lived during that 12 month period.
.......................................................................................................................................

Address Length of time

7. Put a cross (X) in the space which applies to you:
Are you Male ................... Are you Single .......... Female ............................... Married ......................
8. Write in these spaces:
Your date of birth ........................................................................................................

(Day) (Month) (Year)

Your age today ....................................................................................................... years
9. Are you a New Zealand citizen? ...............................................................................
10. If you are not a New Zealand citizen, do you have the status of a Permanent
Resident of Niue?
.....................................................................................................................................
11. On what grounds do you claim that status?
.....................................................................................................................................
12. Have you at some time resided continuously in Niue for not less than 3 years?
..................................................................................................................................... Signed and declared by the applicant this day of 20 .
Signature of applicant: ...................................................................................................
Signature of witness: ......................................................................................................

(Witness must be a registered elector, or Electoral Officer, or a Postmaster)

Niue Assembly Act 1966

Section 17(4) Form 2
NOTICE OF TRANSFER
1289
To the Registrar for the ........................................................................... Constituency.
PLEASE remove from your electoral roll the name of (Surname), (Christian name), (Address on former roll), (Occupation on former roll), (Sex), as the elector was registered in this constituency on (Date).
................................................................. Registrar for the .............................. Constituency
Section 19(a) Form 3
NOTICE OF OBJECTION BY ELECTOR
To the Registrar for the ........................................................................... Constituency. I, (Name in full), of (postal address in full), hereby give notice that I object
* to the registration on any roll of (name in full), of (postal address in fuln( �br/>* to the retention of the name of (name in full) of (postal address in full),
on the roll for the........................................Constituency.
The grounds of my objection are the following: ........................................................
........................................................................................................................................... Dated this.....................................day of...........................20...............
*Delete words that do not apply
Signature: ...................................................
Section 20(b) Form 4
NOTICE OF OBJECTION BY REGISTRARY
To Take notice that I object
* to your registration on any electoral roll
* to the retention of your name on the roll for the.....................................Constituency
on the following grounds:
Unless the annexed notice of appeal is signed by you and returned to me within
days from this date, your name will be removed from the roll without further
proceedings.
Dated this.....................................day of...........................20...............
Registrar: ....................................................
*Delete words that do not apply
Constituency: .............................................
1290 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
NOTICE OF APPEAL
To the Registrar for the...................................................Constituency
Take notice that I appeal from your objection to my registration
* on any electoral roll
* on the roll for the...............................................Constituency on the following
grounds:
Dated this.....................................day of...........................20...............
Signature and address: ...................................................................................................
*Delete words that do not apply
Section 23(2) Form 5
ELECTORAL ROLL FOR................................................CONSTITUENCY
Roll of Persons Entitled to Vote
For a Representative for the...............................................Constituency

Number on Roll Name in Full, Residence, Occupation, Sex

............................................................Registrar
Section 33 Form 6
NOMINATION PAPER
To the Chief Electoral Officer:
WE (name), and (name), being registered on the Electoral Roll for the
.......................Constituency hereby nominate (name, residence, occupation),
registered on the roll for the.......................................Constituency, with his consent,
as a candidate at the election of a Representative for the..............................
Constituency, the holding of which election is appointed for the..................................
day of ............................20............................
Dated this.............................day of..........................20................
To the best of our knowledge, on nomination day, namely the......................day of
20...............(name) will have been ordinarily resident (within the meaning of that
expression as it is defined in section 12 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966) in Niue
throughout the period of 3 months immediately preceding that date and will have
at some period resided continuously in Niue for not less than twelve months.
Dated this........................day of..........................20.....................
A.B. C.D.
(Full names, residences and occupations)
I, (name) hereby consent
* to the above nomination

Niue Assembly Act 1966

CONSENT
1291
* to my nomination as a candidate at the election of a .............................................. representative for the .................................Constituency for the Common electoral role by A.B. and C.D.
And I solemnly declare that throughout the period of three months immediately preceding nomination day, namely the..........................day of......................20.........I have been ordinarily resident (within the meaning of that expression as it is defined in section 12 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966) in Niue.
(Full name, residence & occupation)
*Delete words that do not apply.
Section 37 Form 7
NOTICE OF WITHDRAWAL OF NOMINATION
To the Chief Electoral Officer :
I hereby give notice that I withdraw my name as a candidate at the election of a representative for the ...............................Constituency for the Common electoral role, the holding of which election is appointed for the.........................day of..................20......................
Signature of candidate: ........................... Received at the hour of ...........on the................day of..................20.................
Signature of Chief Electoral Officer
Section 43 Form 8
Election of a Representative of the
...........................................Constituency Ballot Paper
Directions
Strike out the name of every candidate except the one for whom you wish to vote. You must not vote for more than one candidate.
After voting, fold this paper and place it in the ballot box. You must not take it out of the polling booth.
If you spoil this paper, return it to the Presiding Officer and obtain another.
Lipitoa
Makaola
Sisipi
Tusini, Mose
Tusini, Sione
1292 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
Form 8A
Election of Representatives for the
Common Electoral Roll
DIRECTIONS
1. Strike out the name of every candidate except those for whom you wish to
vote.
2. You must not vote more than once.
3. After voting fold this paper and place it in the ballot box.
4. You must not take it out of the polling booth.
5. If you spoil this paper, return it to the Presiding Officer and obtain another.
Section 43(4) Form 9
COUNTERFOIL FOR BALLOT PAPER
Consecutive No.................................
To be entered here and also on the top right-hand corner of the back of the ballot paper.
....................................................................
Designation of Roll:
(To be entered here only)
....................................................................

Stamp across the perforation so that the

)

Official

official booth stamp on the polling place

)

Booth

shall appear on both the counterfoil and

)

Stamp

the ballot paper.

Initials of Presiding Officer:
........................................................... Sections 50, 51
Form 10
DECLARATION BY RETURNING OFFICER, POLL CLERKS,
SCRUTINEERS AND OTHER OFFICERS
I, A.B, solemnly declare that I will faithfully and impartially according to the best of my skill and judgment, exercise and perform all the powers or duties reposed in or required of me by the Niue Assembly Act 1966, and I solemnly promise that I will not, except as provided by the said Act directly or indirectly disclose any fact coming to my knowledge at any election.
Signature ................................................... Declared and signed at......................this..............................day of .............. 20...........
Before me:
Signature: .................................................. Capacity of witness: .................................

Niue Assembly Act 1966

1293
NOTE: The witness, in the case of a Returning Officer, must be the Chief Electoral Officer. In the case of any other electoral officer or of any scrutineer, the witness must be the Chief Electoral Officer or a Returning Officer.
Section 62
Form 11
TENDERED VOTES LIST
Name of Voter Number in Roll
1. .......................................................... ......................................................
2. .......................................................... ......................................................
3. .......................................................... ...................................................... Each of the abovenamed persons, representing himself to be a voter, applied for a
ballot paper after another person has voted as that voter. Each applicant gave
satisfactory answers to the questions in section 62 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966,
and I therefore entered on this list his name and his number in the electoral roll.
Constituency ...........................................
Polling Booth at: .....................................
.......................................... Presiding Officer
........................................................ 20............
Section 63(2) Form 12
CERTIFICATE FOR SPECIAL VOTES
To the Returning officer for the.............................................Constituency.
Whereas (name, occupation, address) is an elector registered on the electoral roll
for the ............................................. Constituency and has duly applied for a certificate
enabling him to vote in the ............................................. Constituency pursuant to the
provisions of section 63 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966.
I hereby certify that the said (name) is entitled to vote in the
............................................. Constituency at the election appointed to be held on
the...................................day....................... of.........................20...................... Dated this.............................................day of.............................................20.........
Chief Electoral Officer
........................................................ 20............
1294 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
Section 64
Form 13
DECLARATION ON VOTING IN ADVANCE OF POLL
I hereby declare that to the best of my knowledge and belief the following statements are true:
1. My surname and Christian names are:
Surname: ...................................................................................................................... Full Christian name: ..................................................................................................
2. My address is: .............................................................................................................
3. My occupation is: .......................................................................................................
4. I am registered as an elector of the .................................................. Constituency.
5. I am still possessed of the qualification I respect of which I am registered.
6. I have not already voted at this election.
7. I have not applied for a certificate as a special voter pursuant to Section 63 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966.
Signature of elector: ........................................................ Date:.......................................
................................................................
Chief Electoral Officer
Section 70
Form 14
Declaration of Result of Poll
.....................................................Constituency
I hereby declare the result of the poll taken on the ....................................................
.................................day of......................................20................. For the election of a
Number of votes rejected as informal ..................................
I thereby declare the said C.D. to be elected. .................................. Dated at............................................this............................day of...................20.......
A.B.
Chief Electoral officer

Niue Assembly Act 1966

Form 14A Declaration of Result of Poll: Common Electoral Roll
1295
I hereby declare the result of the poll taken on the.......................day of.......................
20........ for the election of six (6) representatives for the common electoral roll to be
as follows:
Candidates Votes Received
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Total number of valid votes .......................... Number of votes rejected as informal ..........................
I therefor declare the candidates numbered from 1 to 6 inclusive to be elected as representatives of the common electoral roll.
Dated at Alofi this...........................day of..................................20....................
Chief Electoral Officer
Section 90 Form 15
PETITION FOR INQUIRY
In the matter of an election of members of the Niue Assembly held on............................the........................day of.................20..............
To................................., Judge of the High Court in Niue. The Petition of the undersigned, namely –
(name, occupation, address), Candidate (name, occupation, address), Elector humbly shows:
1. Your petitioners state that the said election was held on the day of 20 and that A.B. was declared to be elected as a representative for the Constituency for the Common electoral roll:
2. And your petitioners say that (state the facts and grounds on which the petitioners rely).
Wherefore your petitioners pray that it may be determined that the said A.B.* was not duly elected (or that the election was void)* (or) that (name) was duly elected, and ought to have so been declared.
1296 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
Dated at........................this...............................day of................20...............
Signatures: ..............................................
.................................................................
.................................................................
*Delete words which do not apply
1297

NIUE BANK ACT 1994

1994/177 – 28 March 1994

PART 5

CENTRAL BANK

32 Bank to act as Central Bank

33 Powers of Central Bank

PART 6

USE OF WORDS “BANK”, “BANKERAND “BANKING

34 “Bank”, “banker” and “banking”

35 Certain persons exempt from section 34

36 Power to require change of name or title

PART 7

REGISTRATION OF BANKS AND PRUDENTIAL

SUPERVISION OF REGISTERED BANKS

37 Registration and prudential supervision

38 Exercise of powers under this Part

39 Register

40 Application for registration

41 Voluntary removal of name from register

42 Offence

43 Determination of applications

44 Conditions of registration

45 Publication of principles

46 Cancellation of registration

47 Carrying on business in a prudent manner

48 Annual fee

49 Credit assessment of registered banks

50 Public disclosure of financial and other

information by registered banks

51 Disclosure statements to be signed

52 Bank may require disclosure statement to

be corrected

53 Interpretation

54 Content of advertisements by registered

banks

55 Regulations

56 Offence to advertise in contravention of

regulations

57 Bank may prohibit advertisements by

registered banks

58 Offences in relation to disclosure

statements and advertisements

59 Civil liability

60 Defences

1298 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 8

FINANCIAL AND OTHER MATTERS

85 Financial year

86 Notional surplus income

87 Funding agreements

88 Contents of funding agreements

89 Funding agreements to be ratified by the

Assembly

90 Application of surplus income

91 Annual report and accounts

92 Contents of financial statements

93 Management statements

94 Auditors

95 Performance audit

PART 9

INTERNATIONAL COMMERCIAL BANK

96 Bank to act as International Commercial

Bank

97 Appointment of Board of International

Commercial Bank

98 Duties of Board of International

Commercial Bank

99 Powers of International Commercial Bank

100 Liabilities of International Commercial

Bank not to be charge against Niue

Government Account

PART 10

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

101 Isue of Bank notes

102 Obligations under this Act not limited

103 Regulations

104 Consents under regulations

105 Offences against regulations

106 Penalties for offences

107 Evidence

108 No action to lie against certain persons

109 [Spent]

To establish the Niue Bank and to confer certain functions and powers on the

Niue Bank

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Niue Bank Act 1994.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Bank” means the Niue Bank constituted under this Act;
“Board” means the Board of Directors of the Bank constituted by section
21;

Niue Bank Act 1994

1299
“document” means a document in any form, whether signed or initialled or otherwise authenticated by its maker or not, and includes –
(a) Any writing on any material;
(b) Any information recorded or stored by means of any tape-recorder,
computer, or other device; and any material subsequently derived
from information so recorded or stored;
(c) Any label, marking, or other writing that identifies or describes
any thing of which it forms part, or to which it is attached by any
means;
(d) Any book, map, plan, graph, or drawing;
(e) Any photograph, film, negative, tape or other device in which one
or more visual images are embodied so as to be capable (with or
without the aid of some other equipment) of being reproduced;
“foreign exchange” means –
(a) The bank notes or other currency, postal notes or money orders of
any country other than Niue, the Cook Islands and New Zealand;
(b) Promissory notes and bills of exchange payable otherwise than in
New Zealand currency;
(c) A right to receive payment otherwise than in New Zealand currency;
(d) An obligation to make payment otherwise than in Niue currency;
(e) A security in respect of which any amount is payable in a country
other than Niue or is payable otherwise than in New Zealand
currency;
“Minister” means the Minister of Finance;
“registered bank” means a person whose name is entered in the register
maintained under section 39;
“security” means any interest or right to participate in any capital, assets,
earnings, royalties, or other property of any person, and includes –
(a) Any interest in or right to be paid money that is, or is to be, deposited
with, lent to, or otherwise owing by, any person (whether or not
the interest or right is secured by a charge over any property); and
(b) Any renewal or variation of the terms or conditions of any existing
security.

3 Act to bind the Government

This Act shall bind the Government.

4 Establishment of Bank

PART 2
THE NIUE BANK
(1) There is hereby established a Bank to be called the Niue Bank.
(2) The Bank shall be a body corporate with perpetual succession and a
common seal.
(3) Without limiting any other provision of this Act, the Bank shall, in the
exercise of its functions and powers under this Act, have the rights, powers and
privileges of a natural person.
(4) The common seal of the Bank shall be judicially noted in all courts and
for all purposes.
(5) The common seal shall be used only with the authority of the Board
and every instrument to which the seal is affixed shall be signed by the Minister
or a person appointed by the Board for that purpose.
1300 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

5 Branches and agencies

The Bank may establish branches and agencies and appoint agents in Niue
or elsewhere.
PART 3
FUNCTIONS AND POWERS OF NIUE BANK

6 Functions of the Bank

The Bank shall have the following functions and purposes –
(a) To act as a Central Bank under Parts 5 to 8;
(b) To act as an International Commercial Bank under Part 9; and
(c) To administer the Acts prescribed by regulations made under this
Act.

7 Dealing in foreign exchange

For the purposes of performing its functions and fulfilling its obligations
under this Act or any other Act, the Bank may deal in foreign exchange with such
persons, including the Crown, and on such terms and conditions as the Bank thinks
fit with the concurrence of Cabinet.

8 Foreign exchange gains and losses

(1) The Bank shall pay into the Niue Government Account any exchange
gains (whether realised or unrealised) made by the Bank as a result of dealing in
foreign exchange under section 7.
(2) The Minister shall upon the appropriation of the Assembly, pay to the
Bank out of the Niue Government Account the amount of any exchange losses
(whether realised or unrealised) incurred by the Bank as a result of dealing in
foreign exchange under section 7.

9 Foreign exchange

The Bank shall advise the Minister and Cabinet on –
(a) Foreign exchange rate systems;
(b) The management of foreign reserves;
(c) The operation of the foreign exchange market;
(d) Any other matters relating to foreign exchange.

10 Foreign reserves

(1) The Minister in concurrence with Cabinet shall in consultation with
the Bank, determine the level at which, or the levels within which, foreign reserves
shall be maintained for the purpose of enabling the Bank to exercise the powers
conferred by this Act.
(2) The Bank shall hold and maintain foreign reserves of that level or within
those levels and, for that purpose, but without limiting the power of the Bank
under this Act, may in concurrence with Cabinet –
(a) Acquire and deal in foreign currency;
(b) Deal in foreign currency on behalf of the Crown;
(c) Appoint any person to acquire and deal in foreign currency on
behalf of the Crown or the Bank.

11 Bank may raise loans

The Bank may, if it appears to be necessary or expedient in the public interest
to do so, raise loans from any person, organisation, or government, either within
or outside Niue, upon such terms and conditions as may be prescribed by Act.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1301

12 Lender of last resort

The Bank shall, if the Bank considers it necessary for the purpose of
maintaining the soundness of the Niue financial system, and only with the prior
approval of Cabinet, act as lender of last resort for the financial system.

13 Settlement account services

The Bank may provide settlement account services for financial institutions
on such terms and conditions as may be determined by agreement.

14 Financial sector policy advice

The Bank shall advise Cabinet and the Minister on matters relating to the
operation of the Niue financial system.

15 Government banking business

(1) The Bank may, under an agreement with the Minister, undertake all or
part of the banking business of the Government.
(2) Any such agreement may provide for the Bank to charge for the
provision of banking services.

16 Securities registry services

(1) The Bank may provide securities registry services for any person
including services in connection with –
(a) The issue, registration, exchange, transfer, or replacement of
securities;
(b) The calling and acceptance of tenders or applications for securities;
(c) The making or receiving of payment in respect of any security.
(2) Securities registry services may be provided for such remuneration,
and on such terms and conditions, as may be agreed by the Bank and the person
for whom they are provided.

17 Bank may require financial institution to supply information

(1) For the purposes of enabling the Bank to carry out the functions and
exercise the powers conferred on it by this Part, the Bank may, by notice in writing
to any financial institution, or by notice in the Gazette, require the institution or, as
the case may be, institutions of a certain class, to supply to the Bank such
information and data relating to the business of the institution or institutions of
the relevant class for such periods, and in such form, as may be specified in the
notice.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), a notice may require information and data to be supplied relating to the assets and liabilities, income and expenditure (including interest rates charged and payable), fees and charges, obligations and commitments, and risk exposures of, and classes of transactions entered into by, that institution or class of institutions and any associated person and, where specified, in consolidated form, in respect of business carried on in Niue or elsewhere and whether as principal, broker, agent, or intermediary.
(3) Any notice given under this section may, by a subsequent notice, be revoked, varied, or amended by the Bank.
(4) Information and data required to be supplied under this section shall be supplied to the Bank at such place in Niue and at such time as are specified in the notice.
(5) A financial institution shall not be required to supply data or information under this section relating to the affairs of a particular customer or client.
1302 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

18 Failure to supply information

Every financial institution commits an offence if, without lawful justification
or excuse, it –
(a) Fails to comply in any respect with any of the provisions of section
17 or of any requirements of the Bank under that section; or
(b) Supplies any information or data which it is required to supply
under section 17 which is false or misleading in any material
particular.

19 Requirement that information be audited

(1) Where the Bank believes that any information or data supplied by a
financial institution under section 17 is, or may be, inadequate or inaccurate, it
may, by notice in writing to that financial institution, require that information or
data to be audited by an auditor approved by the Bank.
(2) Every financial institution commits an offence if without lawful
justification or excuse, it fails to comply with a requirement under subsection (1).

20 Powers

Without limiting section 4 or any other provision of this Act, the Bank, has
power, whether in Niue or elsewhere, to –
(a) Carry on the business of banking;
(b) Issue securities;
(c) Give a fixed or floating charge over all or any part of the undertaking
or property of the Bank;
(d) Enter into agreements or arrangements and obtain assurances
necessary or desirable for carrying out its functions and exercising
its powers;
(e) Carry on any business or exercise any powers, not inconsistent with
any other function of the Bank, which can be conveniently carried
on, or exercised in conjunction with its functions and the exercise
of its powers;
(f) Do any act or perform any function or duty imposed upon it or
required to be done under any other Act.

21 Board of Directors

PART 4
MANAGEMENT OF NIUE BANK
There shall be a Board of Directors of the Bank.

22 Duties of Board

Subject to this Act, the Board of the Bank shall –
(a) Keep under constant review the performance of the Bank in carrying
out its functions;
(b) Ensure that the Bank carries out the functions imposed on it by this
Act;
(c) Ensure that the resources of the Bank are properly and effectively
managed;
(d) Direct the exercise of powers granted to the Bank by this Act.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1303

23 Membership of Board

(1) The Board shall consist of 3 members.
(2) The Board shall comprise –
(a) The Minister;
(b) Two non-executive directors to be appointed by Cabinet.
(3) The validity of the acts of the Board is not affected by any vacancy in its
membership.

24 Term of office of non-executive directors

(1) Every non-executive director appointed under this Act shall be
appointed for terms not exceeding 2 years.
(2) A non-executive director may be reappointed.
(3) A non-executive director may, at any time, resign office by notice in
writing to the Minister.

25 Appointment of non-executive directors

In considering the appointment or reappointment of a person to the office
of non-executive director of the Bank, Cabinet shall have regard, in relation to
that office, to –
(a) That person’s knowledge, skill and experience; and
(b) The likelihood of any conflict between the interests of the Bank and
any interests which that person has or represents.

26 Extraordinary vacancies

(1) If a non-executive director dies, or resigns or is removed from office,
that office shall become vacant and the vacancy shall be deemed to be an
extraordinary vacancy.
(2) A non-executive director shall be deemed to have resigned from office
if that director –
(a) Is prohibited by section 27 from holding office as a director; or
(b) Fails, without the Board’s consent, to attend 3 consecutive meetings
of the Board.
(3) The manner of filling an extraordinary vacancy shall be the same
manner as prescribed by section 23.
(4) A person who is appointed to fill an extraordinary vacancy shall be
appointed for the residue of the term of the vacating director.

27 Disqualification of non-executive directors

No person shall be appointed, or reappointed to the office of non-executive
director of the Bank, or hold that office, if that person –
(a) Is an employee of a registered bank; or
(b) Is an undischarged bankrupt; or
(c) Has been convicted of any offence of dishonesty or any other offence
if that other offence is punishable by imprisonment for a term of 3
years or more; or
(d) Is a mentally disordered person.
1304 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

28 Removal from office of non-executive directors

Cabinet may, on the advice of the Minister, remove a non-executive director
of the Bank from office if Cabinet is satisfied that the director –
(a) Is unable, or has failed, to perform the duties of a director of the
Bank ; or
(b) Has been guilty of misconduct; or
(c) Has obstructed, hindered, or prevented the Board from discharging
the responsibilities of the Board.

29 Meetings of Board

(1) The Board of the Bank shall meet at least 3 times in each year.
(2) The Minister shall convene and preside at meetings of the Board.
(3) If the Minister is absent from a meeting, the non-executive directors
shall convene a meeting in the Minister ’s absence.
(4) (a) Decisions of the Board shall be made by a majority of the votes of
the directors present.
(b) If only 2 of the directors are present, the decision must be
unanimous.
(5) Subject to this section, the Board may regulate its own procedure.

30 Directors to disclose interests

(1) A director who is interested in a contract or proposed contract with the
Bank, or in the exercise or proposed exercise by the Bank of a power, shall declare
that interest at every meeting of the Board at which that contract or proposed
contract, or the exercise or proposed exercise of the power is considered by the
Board.
(2) A director who is interested in a contract or proposed contract or in the exercise or proposed exercise of a power shall not be entitled to vote on a resolution that relates to the contract or proposed contract or the exercise or proposed exercise of the power.

31 Fees and expenses of non-executive directors

The Bank shall pay the non-executive directors such fees as the Minister
after considering any recommendation by the Board, determines.
PART 5
CENTRAL BANK

32 Bank to act as Central Bank

The Bank shall act as the Central Bank of Niue under Parts 6 to 8.

33 Powers of Central Bank

In discharging its functions under section 32, the Bank shall have the powers
prescribed in sections 7 to 19.
PART 6
USE OF WORDS “BANK”, “BANKERAND “BANKING

34 “Bank”, “banker” and “banking”

(1) Except as otherwise provided in this Part, no individual or body
(whether incorporated or not) shall be formed or registered, carry on any business,
trade, or occupation under any name or title that includes the words “bank”,
“banker” or “banking”, or any of those words as part of any other word.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1305
(2) Every person or body who contravenes subsection (1) commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units in the case of an individual or to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units in the case of a body corporate.
(3) For the purposes of this section and section 35, a reference to the words “bank”, “banker” or “banking” includes a reference to a translation of those words in another language.

35 Certain persons exempt from section 34

(1) Nothing in section 34 applies to –
(a) The Bank;
(b) A registered bank under this Act;
(c) Any body (whether incorporated or not) that is formed or registered
in a country other than Niue under a name or title that includes the
words “bank”, “banker” or “banking”, or any of those words as
part of any other word, that is authorised for the time being by the
Bank to use those words, or any of those words as part of any other
word, in connection with the establishment or operation of a
representative office in Niue;
(d) A subsidiary of a registered bank that is authorised for the time
being by the Bank to use those words, or any of those words as part
of any other word;
(e) [Spent]
(f) Any bank carrying on business in Niue at the time this provision is
enacted.
(2) Nothing in section 34 prevents a body (whether incorporated or not)
being formed or registered, or carrying on any business, trade or occupation, under
a name or title that includes the words “bank”, “banker” or “banking” where
those words signify –
(a) Any geographic place name; or
(b) The name of any town or road; or
(c) The surname of any person.
(3) An authorisation or consent under this section may be given subject to
such conditions as the Bank thinks fit.
(4) The Bank may, by notice in writing to the person to whom the
authorisation or consent has been given –
(a) Revoke the authorisation or consent;
(b) Vary, alter, or remove any condition of the authorisation or consent
or add a further condition to it.

36 Power to require change of name or title

(1) Where the Bank is satisfied that a person has contravened, or is
contravening, section 34 it may, by notice in writing to that person and whether or
not that person has been convicted of an offence against that section, require that
person to change its name or title.
(2) Every person to whom a notice has been given under subsection (1)
shall comply with the notice within 4 weeks after receiving it or within such longer
period as the Bank may allow.
1306 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 7
REGISTRATION OF BANKS AND PRUDENTIAL SUPERVISION OF REGISTERED BANKS

37 Registration and prudential supervision

The Bank shall under this Part –
(a) Register banks; and
(b) Undertake prudential supervision of registered banks.

38 Exercise of powers under this Part

The powers conferred on the Cabinet, the Minister and the Bank by this
Part shall be exercised for the purposes of –
(a) Promoting the maintenance of a sound and efficient financial
system; or
(b) Avoiding significant damage to the financial system that could result
from failure of a registered bank.

39 Register

(1) The Bank shall maintain a register of persons to be known as “registered
banks”.
(2) The register shall be available for public inspection at the head office of
the Bank during normal business hours.

40 Application for registration

(1) No person who is not registered as a bank under this Act shall carry on
banking business in Niue.
(2) Applications to be registered as a registered bank shall be –
(a) Made in such manner as may be specified by the Bank; and
(b) Accompanied by payment of such fee as may be determined by the
Bank and approved by the Minister by notice in the Gazette.
(3) Every person who makes an application under this section shall furnish
to the Bank such information as may be required by the Bank to assist in
determining the application.

41 Voluntary removal of name from register

(1) A registered bank may, by notice in writing, require the Bank to remove
the name of that registered bank from the register on a date specified in the notice,
not being a date earlier than 14 days, or such shorter period as the Bank may
agree to, after the date the notice is given.
(2) The registered bank shall, within 7 days of giving that notice, give public
notice of the fact that it had given the notice to the Bank.
(3) The Bank shall remove the name of the registered bank from the register
on the date specified in the notice and shall give notice of the removal in the name
in the Gazette.
(4) Except with the consent of the Bank, a registered bank shall not give
notice under subsection (1) if –
(a) A notice has been given to that registered bank under section
67(1)(c)(i); or
(b) A person has been appointed under section 67(1)(c)(ii) to exercise,
in relation to that registered bank, the powers conferred by that
paragraph; or
(c) A person has been appointed under section 69 to carry out an
investigation of the affairs of that registered bank; or
(d) A notice is in force under section 79 in relation to that registered
bank.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1307
(5) The Bank may refuse to remove the name of a registered bank from the register if –
(a) A notice has been given to the registered bank under section
67(1)(c)(i); or
(b) A person has been appointed under section 67(1)(c)(ii) to exercise,
in relation to that registered bank, the powers conferred by that
paragraph; or
(c) A person has been appointed under section 69 to carry out an
investigation into the affairs of that registered bank; or
(d) A notice is in force under section 79 in relation to that registered
bank.

42 Offence

(1) No person other than a registered bank shall carry on banking business
in Niue or use any name, title, style, or designation or use any description which
represents or implies that that person is a registered bank.
(2) Every person who contravenes subsection (1) commits an offence and
is liable on summary conviction –
(a) In the case of an individual, to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units;
and
(b) In the case of a body corporate, to a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.
(3) No person referred to in section 35(1) can be guilty of an offence under
this section.

43 Determination of applications

(1) The Bank shall not register any person as a registered bank unless it is
satisfied that the business carried on, or proposed to be carried on, by the applicant
consists of, or to a substantial extent consists of, or will to a substantial extent,
consist of, the borrowing and lending of money, or the provision of other financial
services, or both.
(2) In determining an application under section 40, the Bank shall have
regard to –
(a) The incorporation and ownership structure of the applicant;
(b) The size of the applicant’s business or proposed business;
(c) The ability of the applicant to carry on its business or the proposed
business in a prudent manner;
(d) The standing of the applicant in the financial market;
(e) In any case where the applicant is a body corporate incorporated
outside Niue or an unincorporated body having its head office or
principal place of business outside Niue, the law and regulatory
requirements relating to the licensing, registration or authorisation
of banks of the country in which that body is incorporated or in
which that unincorporated body has its head office or principal
place of business and their application to any registered bank having
its head office or principal place of business in Niue;
(f) In any case where the applicant is a subsidiary of any body corporate
incorporated outside Niue, the law and regulatory requirements
relating to the licensing, registration, or authorisation of banks of
the country in which the body corporate which the Bank considers
exercises ultimate control of the applicant is incorporated and their
application to any registered bank having its head office or principal
place of business in Niue;
(g) Such other matters as may be prescribed in regulations.
1308 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) For the purposes of subsection (2)(g), Cabinet may on the advice of the Minister given under a recommendation of the Bank, make regulations prescribing additional matters to which the Bank shall have regard in considering applications for registration.
(4) The Bank shall give notice in the Gazette of the registration of any person as a registered bank under this section.

44 Conditions of registration

(1) A person may be registered as a registered bank unconditionally, or
subject to such conditions as the Bank may specify.
(2) The Bank may by notice in writing to a registered bank –
(a) In a case where the bank has been registered unconditionally or
has been deemed to have been registered, impose conditions of
registration;
(b) Vary or remove any condition, whether imposed on the registration
of the bank or under paragraph (a), or add to any such condition.
(3) The Bank shall not –
(a) Impose conditions of registration under subsection (2)(a); or
(b) Vary or add to conditions of registration under subsection (2)(b)
unless the registered bank is given notice in writing of the Bank’s
intention to do so, has a reasonable opportunity to make
submissions to the Bank, and the Bank has regard to those
submissions.
(4) The Bank may specify conditions that relate to any of the following
matters –
(a) The matters to which the Bank is required to have regard under section 43 in determining an application for registration including any matters prescribed by regulations made under that section; and
(b) The matters referred to in section 43 including any matters
prescribed by regulations made under that section.

45 Publication of principles

The Bank shall publish the principles on which it acts,or proposes to act –
(a) In determining applications for registration; and
(b) In imposing, varying, removing, or adding to conditions of
registration.

46 Cancellation of registration

(1) Cabinet may on the advice of the Minister given in accordance with a
recommendation of the Bank, cancel the registration of a registered bank.
(2) The Bank shall not make a recommendation under subsection (1) unless
it is satisfied –
(a) That the registered bank was registered on information that was
false or misleading in a material particular; or
(b) That the registered bank has suffered a material loss of standing in
the financial market since being registered; or
(c) If the registered bank is a body corporate –
(i) that an order has been made for the winding up of that body
corporate; or
(ii) that a resolution has been passed for the voluntary winding
up of that body corporate; or

Niue Bank Act 1994

1309
(iii) that a receiver has been appointed in respect of that body corporate; or
(d) If the registered bank is a partnership – (i) that the partnership is dissolved; or
(ii) that, if a member of the partnership is a body corporate, an event referred to in paragraph (c) has occurred in relation to that member; or
(iii) that a member of the partnership is adjudged bankrupt or has made a composition or arrangement with that member ’s creditors; or
(e) That a condition of registration has not been complied with; or
(f) That the registered bank has not carried on its business in a prudent
manner;
(g) That the registered bank has been involved in any illegal activity or
has been knowingly involved in the laundering of the proceeds of
sale of any prohibited narcotic substances or the laundering of the
proceeds gained from any other serious criminal activity, whether
that sale or laundering or other serious criminal activity occurred
in Niue or elsewhere; or
(h) That the registered bank has failed to comply with an obligation
imposed under this Act.
(3) The Bank shall not make a recommendation under subsection (1)
unless –
(a) The registered bank is given not less than 14 days’ notice in writing of the Bank’s intention to consider making the recommendation; and
(b) The registered bank has a reasonable opportunity to make
submissions to the Bank; and
(c) The Bank has regard to those submissions.
(4) A copy of any written submission made by the registered bank shall be
sent to the Minister together with any recommendation by the Bank.
(5) The Bank shall, as soon as practicable after the making of an order in
Cabinet cancelling the registration of a registered bank, give notice in writing to
the bank stating the grounds on which the Bank’s recommendation was made.

47 Carrying on business in a prudent manner

(1) In –
(a) Having regard, under section 43(2)(c) to the ability of an applicant
for registration as a registered bank to carry on its business or
proposed business in a prudent manner; or
(b) Determining under section 46(2)(f) that a registered bank has not
carried on its business in a prudent manner, the Bank shall confine
its consideration to the following matters –
(i) Capital in relation to the size and nature of the business or
proposed business;
(ii) Loan concentration or proposed loan concentration and risk
exposures or proposed risk exposures;
(iii) Separation of the business or proposed business from other
business and from other interests of any person owning or
controlling the applicant or registered bank;
(iv) Internal controls and accounting systems or proposed internal
controls and accounting systems;
(v) Such other matters as may be prescribed in regulations.
1310 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) Cabinet may, on the advice of the Minister given in accordance with a recommendation of the Bank, make regulations prescribing additional matters for the purposes of subsection (1).
(3) The Board shall issue, in such manner as the Board may determine, guidelines for the purpose of interpreting any of the matters referred to in subsection (1)(b)(i).

48 Annual fee

(1) Every registered bank shall pay to the Bank an annual fee of such
amount as may be determined by the Bank, approved by the Minister, and notified
in the Gazette.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1) –
(a) Different fees may be determined for different classes of registered
banks;
(b) In determining fees the Bank may have regard to the anticipated
costs of the Bank in exercising the powers conferred by this Part.

49 Credit assessment of registered banks

(1) The Bank may by notice in writing to all registered banks or to all
members of any class of registered banks, require each of those banks –
(a) To undergo an independent assessment of its credit worthiness or
financial stability by a person or organisation nominated or
approved by the Bank; and
(b) To publish the results of that assessment in such manner as the
Bank directs.
(2) Every registered bank shall comply with a notice given under this
section.

50 Public disclosure of financial and other information by registered banks

(1) The Bank shall, by notice in the Gazette, prescribe the information which,
on the approval of the notice by Cabinet under subsection (5), shall be published
by all registered banks or any specified class of registered banks.
(2) The information shall be contained in a document to be known as a
“disclosure statement” and shall be published in the manner and on such occasions
as shall be specified in the notice.
(3) Without limiting the information which may be prescribed, a notice
under subsection (1) may prescribe information relating to –
(a) Directors, principal officers, secretaries, auditors, bankers, and
solicitors;
(b) Incorporation and ownership structure;
(c) Financial and accounting systems and controls;
(d) Assets and liabilities including asset and liability maturities;
(e) Income and expenditure;
(f) Fees and charges including interest rates charged and payable;
(g) Capital structure;
(h) Loan concentrations and risk exposures;
(i) Liquidity;
(j) Obligations and commitments including contingent liabilities;
(k) Foreign exchange and interest rate exposures;
(l) Pending proceedings and arbitrations;
(m) Acquisitions.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1311
(4) Without limiting subsection (1) or subsection (3), a notice under subsection (1) may –
(a) Prescribe information that is required to be contained under normal accounting principles in financial statements;
(b) Require the publication of financial statements and notes to those statements for any period or periods specified in the notice;
(c) Require financial statements and information to be published in consolidated form;
(d) Require financial information which is required to be published to
be taken from audited financial statements;
(e) Require financial statements and information which are required
to be published to be audited and to be accompanied by an auditor ’s
report.
(5) The Cabinet may, by order –
(a) In a case where a notice under subsection (1) prescribes information
to be published by all registered banks, approve that notice, and on
the coming into force of that order, every registered bank shall
publish that information in the form and in the manner prescribed;
(b) In a case where a notice under subsection (1) prescribes information
to be published by a specified class of registered banks, approve
that notice, and on the coming into force of that order, every
registered bank which is a member of that class shall publish that
information in the form and in the manner prescribed.
(6) A registered bank shall not be required to publish information relating
to the affairs of any particular customer or client of the bank.
(7) The Bank shall consult with the Government before it prescribes
information which shall be published and the manner in which it shall be
published, under this section, by registered banks or any specified class of
registered banks.
(8) If the auditor ’s report required under subsection (4)(e) is qualified in
any way, this may constitute a reasonable ground for the exercise of those powers
conferred on the Bank by sections 79 to 84.

51 Disclosure statements to be signed

Every disclosure statement which a registered bank is required to publish
under section 50 shall be dated and shall be signed –
(a) In the case of a body corporate, by every director of the body
corporate or by that director ’s agent authorised in writing; and
(b) In the case of a partnership, by every member of the partnership or
by that member ’s agent authorised in writing.

52 Bank may require disclosure statement to be corrected

Where the Bank considers that a disclosure statement published by a
registered bank –
(a) Contains information that is false or misleading; or
(b) Does not contain information which it is required to contain,
whether or not the information contained in the disclosure statement
is false or misleading as a result of the omission;
the Bank may, by notice in writing to the registered bank, require the registered
bank to –
(i) publish a disclosure statement that does not contain false or misleading information; or
1312 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(ii) publish a disclosure statement that contains the information that was omitted; or
(iii) take such other corrective action as the Bank may specify in the notice.

53 Interpretation

For the purposes of sections 54 to 60 –
“advertisement” means a form of communication –
(a) That is to be, or has been, distributed to any person by any means;
and
(b) That is authorised or instigated by or on behalf of a registered bank
or prepared with the co-operation of, or by arrangement with, a
registered bank; and
(c) That contains, or refers to, an offer of debt securities by a registered
bank, or is reasonably likely to induce persons to subscribe for debt
securities of the registered bank;
“debt security” in relation to a registered bank, means any interest in or
right to be paid money that is, or is to be, deposited with, lent to, or
otherwise owing by, that registered bank (whether or not the interest
or right is secured by a charge over any property), and includes –
(a) A debenture, debenture stock, bond note, certificate of deposit, and
convertible note; and
(b) Any renewal or variation of the terms or conditions of any existing
debt security; and
(c) Any security that is declared by Cabinet, to be a debt security for
the purposes of this Act.

54 Content of advertisements by registered banks

(1) Every advertisement by a registered bank shall comply with the
requirements prescribed by regulations made under this Act.
(2) This section shall come into force on a date to be appointed by order of
Cabinet.

55 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may, on the advice of the Minister given in accordance with a
recommendation of the Bank, make regulations for the following purposes –
(a) Regulating advertising and advertisements by registered banks
including –
(i) prescribing the information, statements, certificates, documents,
or other matters that shall or shall not be contained in, or
endorsed on, or attached to, advertisements;
(ii) prohibiting or restricting the use in advertisements of prescribed
words, information, statements, sounds and images, graphics,
or other matters;
(iii) prescribing requirements as to the layout or presentation of
advertisements and the size of printing used in advertisements
– and different matters may be prescribed, prohibited, restricted,
specified, or required in respect of different classes of
advertisements;
(b) Prescribing offences in respect of the contravention of or non­
compliance with any regulations made under paragraph (a), and
prescribing the fines, not exceeding, in the case of an individual 50

Niue Bank Act 1994

1313
penalty units, and in the case of a body corporate, 500 penalty units, that may be imposed in respect of any offence.
(2) The Bank shall consult with Cabinet before it makes a recommendation under subsection (1).

56 Offence to advertise in contravention of regulations

(1) If an advertisement that does not comply with the requirements
prescribed by regulations made under this Act is distributed to any person –
(a) The registered bank; and
(b) Every person holding office as a director of the registered bank at
the time the advertisement was distributed –
commits an offence.
(2) A registered bank that commits an offence against this section is liable
on conviction to a fine not exceeding 500 penalty units.
(3) An individual who commits an offence against this section is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.
(4) It is a defence to a prosecution for an offence against this section by a
person referred to in subsection (1)(b) if the defendant proves that the
advertisement was published without the defendant’s knowledge and consent.
(5) This section shall come into force on a date to be appointed by order by
Cabinet.

57 Bank may prohibit advertisements by registered banks

(1) Where, at any time, the Bank is of the opinion that an advertisement –
(a) Is likely to deceive, mislead, or confuse with regard to any matter
that is material to an offer of debt securities by a registered bank to
which it relates; or
(b) Is inconsistent with the most recent disclosure statement published
by the registered bank; or
(c) Does not comply with regulations made under this Act –
the Bank may make an order prohibiting the distribution of that advertisement or
any advertisement which relates to the offer of those securities.
(2) Any order may be made on such terms and conditions as the Bank
thinks fit.
(3) Where the Bank makes an order under this section –
(a) It shall forthwith notify the registered bank that the order has been
made and the reasons for making it; and
(b) It may notify any other person that the order has been made and
the reasons for making it.
(4) Every person who contravenes an order made under this section
commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty
units.
(5) It is a defence to a charge under subsection (4) if the defendant proves that the advertisement was distributed –
(a) Without the defendant’s knowledge; or
(b) Without the defendant’s knowledge of the order.
(6) At any time after an order has been made under this section, the
registered bank shall be entitled to appear and be represented before the Bank
and the Bank, if it is satisfied that the order should not continue in force, may
revoke the order.
(7) This section shall come into force on a date to be appointed by order by
Cabinet.
1314 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

58 Offences in relation to disclosure statements and advertisements

(1) Every registered bank commits an offence if, without lawful justification
or excuse, it fails to publish information that is required to publish in a disclosure
statement under section 50.
(2) Where a disclosure statement that includes information that is false or
misleading is published by a registered bank, the registered bank and every person
holding office as a director of the registered bank at the time of publication of the
disclosure statement, commits an offence.
(3) Where an advertisement that contains information that is false or
misleading is distributed, the registered bank and every person holding office as
a director of the bank at the time of distribution of the advertisement, commits an
offence.
(4) A registered bank that commits an offence against this section is liable
on conviction to a fine not exceeding 500 penalty units.
(5) An individual who commits an offence against this section is liable on
conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or to a fine not
exceeding 50 penalty units.
(6) It is a defence to a prosecution for an offence against subsection (2) or
subsection (3), if the defendant proves that the information was immaterial or, in
the case of an individual, that the defendant had reasonable grounds to believe
and did, up to the publication of the disclosure statement, or the distribution of
the advertisement, as the case may be, believe that the information was true.
(7) This section shall come into force on a date to be appointed for the
order by Cabinet.

59 Civil liability

(1) Subject to section 60, the following persons are liable to pay
compensation to any person who sustains a loss by reason of subscribing for any
debt security issued by a registered bank in reliance on false or misleading
information contained in a disclosure statement or an advertisement, namely –
(a) The registered bank; and
(b) Every person holding office as a director of the registered bank at
the time of publication of the disclosure statement or the distribution
of the advertisement, as the case may be.
(2) This section shall come into force on a date to be appointed by order by
Cabinet.

60 Defences

(1) A person is not liable under section 59 in relation to false or misleading
information that is included in a disclosure statement or an advertisement if that
person proves that –
(a) The disclosure statement was published or the advertisement was
distributed without his or her knowledge or consent, and on
becoming aware of the publication or distribution he or she
forthwith gave notice to the Bank that it was published or
distributed without his or her knowledge or consent, and also gave
reasonable public notice that it was published or distributed without
his or her knowledge or consent; or
(b) After publication of the disclosure statement or the distribution of
the advertisement and before the securities were subscribed for, he
or she, on becoming aware of the false or misleading information,
withdrew his or her consent to the disclosure statement or the

Niue Bank Act 1994

1315
advertisement, forthwith gave notice to the Bank of the withdrawal of that consent, and also gave reasonable public notice of the withdrawal of the consent; or
(c) He or she had reasonable grounds to believe and did, up to the time of the subscription for the securities, believe that the statement was true.
(2) This section shall come into force on a date to be appointed by order by
Cabinet.

61 Supply of information for purposes of prudential supervision

(1) For the purposes of this Part, the Bank may, by notice in writing to any
registered bank or by notice in the Gazette applying to any specified class of
registered banks, require the bank, or as the case may be, banks of that class, to
supply to the Bank such information, data, and forecasts relating to the business,
operation, or management of the bank or banks of that class and for such periods
and in such form as may be specified in the notice.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), a notice may require information and
data to be supplied relating to the financial and accounting systems and controls,
assets and liabilities, income and expenditure (including interest rates charged
and payable), fees and charges, obligations and commitments and risk exposures
of, and transactions entered into by, that registered bank or class of registered
banks and any associated person and, where specified, in consolidated form, in
respect of business carried on in Niue, or elsewhere and whether as principal,
broker, agent or intermediary.
(3) A notice given under this section may, by a subsequent notice, be
revoked, varied or amended by the Bank.
(4) Information, data, and forecasts required to be supplied under this
section shall be supplied to the Bank at such place in Niue and at such time as
may be specified in the notice.
(5) Every registered bank commits an offence if, without lawful justification
or excuse it –
(a) Fails to comply in any respect with any of the provisions of this
section or with any of the requirements of the Bank under this
section; or
(b) Supplies any information or data which it is required to supply
under this section which is false or misleading in a material
particular.

62 Requirement that information be audited

(1) The Bank may, by notice in writing to a registered bank, require any
information and data which that bank is required to supply under section 61 to be
audited by an auditor approved by the Bank.
(2) Every registered bank commits an offence if, without lawful justification
or excuse, it fails to comply with this section.

63 Bank may require report on financial and accounting systems

(1) The Bank may, by notice in writing to a registered bank, require that
registered bank to supply the Bank with a report, prepared by a person approved
by the Bank, on the financial and accounting systems and controls of that registered
bank.
(2) Every registered bank commits an offence if, without lawful justification or excuse, it fails to comply with this section.
1316 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

64 Disclosure of information to Bank by auditors

Every person who holds, or at any time has held, office as required by any
enactment, as an auditor of a registered bank, shall disclose to the bank information
relating to the affairs of that registered bank obtained in the course of holding that
office if, in the opinion of that person –
(a) The registered bank is insolvent or is likely to become insolvent or
is in serious financial difficulties; and
(b) The disclosure of that information is likely to assist, or be relevant
to, the exercise by the Bank of its powers under this Part.

65 Auditor to inform registered bank of intention to disclose

Every auditor shall, before disclosing any information to the Bank under
section 64 take reasonable steps to inform the registered bank of the intention to
disclose the information and the nature of the information.

66 Protection of auditors

(1) No civil, criminal, or disciplinary proceedings shall lie against any
auditor arising from the disclosure in good faith of information to the Bank under
section 64.
(2) No tribunal, body, or authority, having jurisdiction in respect of the
professional conduct of any auditor, shall make any order against, or do any act in
relation to, that person in respect of such disclosure.
(3) No information received by the Bank under section 64 shall be
admissible in evidence in any proceedings against the auditor concerned.
(4) Nothing in subsection (3) shall limit the admissibility of any information
obtained in any other way.

67 Powers to obtain information and documents

(1) Where the Bank has reasonable cause to believe –
(a) That any information or data supplied to the Bank by a registered
bank under section 61 is false or misleading in a material particular;
or
(b) That a registered bank has failed to comply with any requirement
to supply information, data, or forecasts under section 61; or
(c) That a registered bank has failed to comply with section 63, it may

(i) by notice in writing to that registered bank, require that
registered bank to supply to the Bank, within the time specified
in the notice, such information and data relating to the business,
operation and management of that registered bank as may be
specified in the notice; or
(ii) appoint, in writing, any person to enter and search any premises
and inspect, remove, and take copies of, any documents or
extracts from documents relating to the business, operation,
and management of that registered bank in the possession, or
under the control, of any person, and, where necessary, require
the reproduction in usable form of any information recorded
or stored in those documents.
(2) Every person commits an offence who, without lawful justification or
excuse, hinders, obstructs, or delays, in the conduct of any inspection under this
section, any person duly authorised to make such inspection.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1317
(3) Every registered bank commits an offence if, without lawful justification or excuse –
(a) It fails to comply with any requirement of the Bank under subsection
(1)(c)(i); or
(b) It supplies any information or data required to be supplied under
subsection 1(c)(i) which is false or misleading in a material
particular.

68 Requirements on entering and searching premises

(1) No person appointed under section 67(1)(c)(ii) shall enter and search
any premises, or inspect, remove, or take copies of any documents, or extracts
from documents, in the possession of, or under the control of, any person, or require
the reproduction in usable form of any information recorded or stored in any
documents, unless –
(a) The occupier of the premises, or the person who has possession of
the documents, agrees; or
(b) That person obtains a warrant under section 74.
(2) Every person authorised to enter and search any premises under a
warrant obtained under section 74 on first entering those premises, and, if
requested, at any subsequent time, produce –
(a) Evidence of that person’s authority to enter the premises; and
(b) Evidence of that person’s identity.

69 Investigation of affairs of registered bank

Where the Bank is satisfied that it is necessary or desirable for the purpose
of determining whether or not to exercise the powers conferred under section 79
that an investigation of the affairs of any registered bank should be carried out,
the Bank may appoint, in writing, any person to carry out an investigation of the
affairs of that registered bank.

70 Powers of person appointed to carry out investigation

(1) Any person appointed under section 69 may, for the purposes of
carrying out an investigation of the affairs of a registered bank –
(a) By notice in writing, require that registered bank, or any officer or
employee of that registered bank, or any other person, to –
(i) supply any information or data relating to the business,
operation, and management of the registered bank;
(ii) produce for inspection any documents of, or relating to, the
business, operation and management of that registered bank
in the custody, or under the control, of that registered bank,
officer, employee, or person;
(iii) where necessary, reproduce in usable form any information
recorded or stored in such documents;
(b) Take copies of any documents produced for inspection under
paragraph (a);
(c) Require any officer or employee of that registered bank, or any other
person, to answer any question relating to the business, operation,
and management of that registered bank.
(2) Subject to section 72, any person appointed under section 69 may, for
the purposes of carrying out an investigation of the affairs of the registered bank,
at any time –
1318 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) Enter and search any premises;
(b) Inspect, remove and take copies of any documents, or extracts from
documents, relating to the business, operation and management of
that registered bank in the possession, or under the control, of any
person;
(c) If necessary, require any person to reproduce in usable form any
information recorded or stored in those documents.

71 Offences in relation to investigations

(1) Every person commits an offence who, without lawful justification or
excuse –
(a) Hinders, obstructs, or delays any person appointed to carry out an investigation under section 69, in carrying out that investigation; or
(b) Refuses to answer any question put to him or her by that person
under section 70; or
(c) Supplies any information required to be supplied under section 70
which is false or misleading in a material particular.
(2) Every registered bank commits an offence if, without lawful justification
or excuse –
(a) It fails to comply with any requirement of a person appointed to
carry out an investigation under section 69; or
(b) It supplies any information or data required to be supplied under
section 70(1) which is false or misleading in a material particular.
(3) A statement made by any person in answer to any question by a person
appointed under section 69 to carry out an investigation into the affairs of a
registered bank shall not be admissible in criminal proceedings against the maker
of the statement.

72 Requirements to be complied with by person carrying out investigation

(1) Any person who exercises any powers conferred by section 70(1) shall,
if requested, produce the instrument of that person’s appointment under section
69.
(2) No person who exercises any powers conferred by section 70(2) shall enter and search any premises, or inspect, remove and take copies of any documents or extracts from documents, or require the reproduction in usable form of any information recorded or stored in documents, unless –
(a) The occupier of the premises, or the person who has possession of
the documents, agrees; or
(b) That person obtains a warrant under section 74.
(3) Every person authorised to enter and search any premises under a
warrant obtained under section 74 shall, on first entering those premises and, if
requested, at any subsequent time, produce –
(a) Evidence of that person’s authority to enter the premises; and
(b) Evidence of that person’s identity.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1319

73 Confidentiality of information

(1) This section applies to –
(a) Information, data, and forecasts supplied or disclosed to, or obtained
by –
(i) the Bank;
(ii) a person appointed under section 67(1)(c)(ii) or section 69 –
under, or for the purposes of, or in connection with the exercise
of powers conferred by this Part;
(b) Information and data derived from or based upon information, data,
and forecasts referred to in paragraph (a);
(c) Information relating to the exercise, or possible exercise, of the
powers conferred by this Part.
(2) Information, data, and forecasts to which this section applies shall not
be published or disclosed by the Bank, any officer or employee of the Bank, or a person appointed under section 67(1)(c)(ii) or section 69, except –
(a) With the consent of the person to whom the information relates; (b) To the extent that the information is available to the public under
any Act, or in a public document;
(c) In statistical or summary form arranged in such a manner as to
prevent any information published or disclosed from being
identified by any person as relating to any particular person;
(d) For the purposes of, or in connection with, the exercise of powers
conferred by this Part;
(e) In connection with any proceedings for an offence against this Act;
(f) To any central bank, authority, or body in any other country which
exercises functions corresponding to or similar to those conferred
on the Bank under this Part for the purposes of the exercise by that
central bank, authority, or body of those functions;
(g) To any person whom the Bank is satisfied has a proper interest in
receiving such information.
(3) No information, data, or forecasts shall be published or disclosed under
subsection (2)(f) or (g) unless the Bank is satisfied that satisfactory provision exists
to protect the confidentiality of the information, data, or forecasts published or
disclosed.
(4) No officer or employee of the Bank and no person appointed under
section 67(1)(c)(ii) or section 69 shall use any information, data, or forecasts to
which this section applies for a purpose not connected with the purpose for which
such information, data, or forecasts was, or were, supplied, disclosed, or obtained.
(5) No person to whom any information, data, or forecasts to which this
section applies is or are published or disclosed under subsection (2)(d) shall publish,
disclose, or use such information, data, or forecasts except –
(a) For the purposes of, or in connection with the exercise of powers
conferred by, this Part; and
(b) Under such conditions as may be specified by the Bank.
(6) No person to whom any information, data or forecasts to which this
section applies is or are published or disclosed under subsection (2)(a) or subsection
(2)(g) shall publish, disclose or use such information, data, or forecasts unless the
publication, disclosure, or use is –
(a) Authorised by the Bank; or
(b) Necessary or desirable in connection with the exercise of any
function or power conferred by any enactment.
1320 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(7) Every person who contravenes this section commits an offence.
(8) Nothing in any other Act applies to information, data and forecasts to
which this section applies whether or not such information, data, and forecasts
has or have been published or disclosed to any person under this section.

74 Procedure for obtaining warrants

(1) If the Court is satisfied, on application in writing, made on oath, that
there are reasonable grounds for believing –
(a) That any information or data supplied to the Bank by a registered
bank under section 61 is false or misleading in a material particular;
or
(b) That a registered bank has failed to comply with any requirement
to supply information, data, or forecasts under section 61;
(c) That a registered bank has failed to comply with section 63 –
it may issue a warrant, in terms of section 75, to a person appointed under section
67(1)(c)(ii).
(2) If the Court is satisfied, on application in writing made on oath, that
there are reasonable grounds for believing that it is necessary for the purpose of
determining whether to exercise the powers conferred under section 79 that an
investigation of the affairs of a registered bank should be carried out, it may issue
a warrant, in terms of section 75, to a person appointed under section 69.
(3) Every warrant issued under subsection (1) shall state whether it is issued
under paragraph (a) or paragraph (b).

75 Effect of warrant

(1) Every warrant issued under section 74 authorises the person named in
it, at any time and, if necessary, by force, to –
(a) Enter and search the premises named in it;
(b) Inspect, remove, and take copies of, documents or extracts from
documents relating to the business, operation and management of
the registered bank in the possession, or under the control, of any
person;
(c) Where necessary, require any information recorded or stored in
those documents to be reproduced in usable form.
(2) The warrant shall continue in force for a period of 6 months or until the
purpose for which it was granted has been satisfied, whichever is the lesser.
(3) Every person named in the warrant shall, as soon as practicable after
removing any documents or extracts from documents from any premises, supply
a copy of the documents or extracts to the person from whom the documents or
extracts were removed.

76 Effect of proceedings

(1) Where any proceedings in any court in respect of the exercise of any
powers conferred by section 67 or section 69 or section 70, until a final decision in
relation to those proceedings is given, the powers may be, or may continue to be
exercised as if no such proceedings had been commenced, and no person shall be
excused from fulfilling any obligation under those sections by reason of those
proceedings.
(2) This section shall apply notwithstanding any other Act or rule of law.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1321

77 Effect of final decision that exercise of powers unlawful

In any case where it is declared in a final decision given in any proceedings
in respect of the exercise of powers conferred by section 67 that the exercise of any
powers conferred by that section is unlawful, to the extent to which the exercise of
those powers is declared unlawful –
(a) The Bank shall ensure that forthwith after the decision of the Court
is given –
(i) any information and data supplied by the registered bank under
section 67(1)(c) is destroyed;
(ii) any documents or extracts from documents obtained under an
inspection made under section 67(1)(c)(i) are returned to the
person previously having possession of those documents or
previously having them under his or her control and any copies
of such documents or extracts are destroyed;
(iii) any information derived from or based upon any such
information and data or documents or extracts is destroyed;
(b) No information and data supplied by the registered bank under
section 67(1)(c) and no documents or extracts from documents
obtained under an inspection made under section 67(1)(c)(i) shall
be –
(i) admissible in evidence in any proceedings;
(ii) used in connection with the exercise of any power conferred
by section 79.

78 Decision that exercise of powers under section 69 or 70 unlawful

In any case where it is declared in a final decision given in any proceedings
in respect of the exercise of powers conferred by section 69 or section 70 that the
exercise of any powers conferred by those sections is unlawful, to the extent to
which the exercise of those powers is declared unlawful –
(a) The Bank shall ensure that forthwith after the decision of the Court
is given –
(i) Any information or data obtained under section 70(1) is
destroyed;
(ii) Any documents produced for inspection under section 70(1)(a)
are returned to the person previously having possession of the
documents or previously having the documents under his or
her control and any copies of such documents or extracts from
documents are destroyed;
(iii) any documents or extracts from documents obtained under an
inspection made under section 70(2) are returned to the person
previously having possession of those documents or previously
having them under his or her control and any copies of such
documents or extracts from documents are destroyed;
(iv) any information derived from or based upon any such
information, documents or extracts is destroyed;
(b) No information or data obtained or documents produced for
inspection under section 70(1)(a) and no documents or extracts from
documents obtained under an inspection made under section 70(2)
shall be –
(i) admissible in evidence in any proceedings;
(ii) used in connection with the exercise of any power conferred
by section 79.
1322 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

79 Bank may require registered bank to consult

(1) If the Bank has reasonable grounds to believe that –
(a) A registered bank is insolvent or is likely to become insolvent; or
(b) A registered bank is about to suspend payment or is unable to meet
its obligations as and when they fall due; or
(c) The affairs of a registered bank are being conducted in a manner
prejudicial to the soundness of the financial system; or
(d) The circumstances of a registered bank are such as to be prejudicial
to the soundness of the financial system; or
(e) The business of a registered bank has not been, or is not being,
conducted in a prudent manner; or
(f) A registered bank has failed to comply with any requirement
imposed by or under this Act or regulations made under this Act;
or
(g) A registered bank has been convicted of an offence against this Act;
or
(h) A registered bank has failed to comply with a condition of its
registration –
the Bank may, by notice in writing, require the registered bank and any associated
person of the registered bank, while the notice is in force to consult with the Bank
as to the circumstances of that registered bank and methods of resolving any
difficulties facing it.
(2) If the Bank has reasonable grounds to believe that –
(a) An associated person of a registered bank is insolvent or is likely to
become insolvent; or
(b) An associated person of a registered bank is about to suspend
payment or is unable to meet its obligations as and when they fall
due; or
(c) The affairs of an associated person of a registered bank are being
conducted in a manner prejudicial to the soundness of the financial
system; or
(d) The circumstances of an associated person of a registered bank are
such as to be prejudicial to the soundness of the financial system –
the Bank may, by notice in writing, require that associated person, the registered
bank, and any other associated person of the registered bank while the notice is in
force to consult with the Bank as to the circumstances of that associated person
and methods of resolving any difficulties facing it.
(3) Every notice under subsection (1) or subsection (2) shall state the
grounds on which it is given.
(4) A registered bank or an associated person, as the case may be, that fails
to comply with a notice under this section commits an offence.
(5) The Bank may, at any time, revoke a notice given under this section.

80 Bank may give advice and assistance

(1) While a notice under section 79(1) is in force in relation to a registered
bank or an associated person, the Bank may –
(a) Give advice to the registered bank or associated person concerning
its affairs;
(b) Give advice and assistance in connection with the negotiation of
any sale or other disposition of the whole or any part of the capital
or business undertaking of that registered bank or associated person;

Niue Bank Act 1994

1323
(c) Give advice and assistance in connection with any scheme for resolving the difficulties of that registered bank;
(d) With the consent of the Minister, by notice in writing to the parties, approve the sale or other disposition of the whole or any part of the capital, or business undertaking, of the registered bank or associated person to any person specified in the notice.
(2) While a notice under section 79(2) is in force in relation to an associated person of a registered bank or the registered bank, the Bank may –
(a) Give advice to the associated person or the registered bank
concerning its affairs;
(b) Give advice and assistance in connection with the negotiation of
any sale or other disposition of the whole or any part of the capital
or business undertaking of that associated person or the registered
bank;
(c) Give advice and assistance in connection with any scheme for
resolving the difficulties of that associated person;
(d) With the consent of the Minister, by notice in writing to the parties,
approve the sale or other disposition of the whole or any part of the
capital, or business undertaking, of the associated person or the
registered bank to any person specified in the notice.

81 Bank may give directions

(1) While a notice under section 79(1) is in force in relation to a registered
bank or an associated person, the Bank may, with the prior consent of the Minister, give a direction in writing –
(a) Requiring that registered bank or associated person to carry on business or any part of its business under the direction;
(b) Requiring that registered bank or associated person to cease to carry on its business, or any part of its business in accordance with the direction;
(c) Requiring that registered bank or associated person to ensure that any officer or employee of the registered bank or associated person ceases to take part in the management or conduct of its business except with the permission of the Bank and so far as that permission extends;
(d) Requiring the registered bank or associated person in general meeting to remove or replace a director;
(e) Requiring the registered bank or associated person to take such
other action as may be specified in the notice.
(2) While a notice under section 79(2) is in force in relation to an associated
person of a registered bank or a registered bank, the Bank may, with the prior
consent of the Minister, give a direction in writing –
(a) Requiring that associated person or the registered bank to carry on
business, or any part of its business, in accordance with the direction;
(b) Requiring that associated person or the registered bank to cease to
carry on its business, or any part of its business under the direction;
(c) Requiring the associated person or registered bank to ensure that
any officer or employee of the associated person or the registered
bank ceases to take part in the management or conduct of its
business except with the permission of the Bank and so far as that
permission extends;
(d) Requiring that associated person or the registered bank in general
meeting to remove or replace a director;
1324 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(e) Requiring that associated person or the registered bank to take such other action as may be specified in the notice.
(3) The Bank may, with the consent of the Minister, amend or modify a direction given under this section or revoke a direction and give another direction in its place, and may, at any time, revoke a direction.

82 Offence to contravene directions

(1) Every person commits an offence who, being a registered bank or
associated person, without lawful justification or excuse, contravenes, or fails to
comply with, a direction under section 81.
(2) Every person commits an offence who, being an officer or employee of
a registered bank or of an associated person, without lawful justification or excuse,
obstructs, hinders or prevents that registered bank or associated person giving
effect to any direction given under section 81.

83 Offence to disclose giving of notice

(1) Subject to subsections (2) and (3) every person commits an offence who
discloses that a notice has been given under section 79 or that a direction has been
given under section 81.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) applies to the disclosure or publication of the
fact that a notice or direction has been given where the disclosure or publication is
made –
(a) To any professional or financial adviser of the registered bank or associated person to which the notice or direction relates;
(b) With the written consent of the Bank, for the purposes of the sale or other disposition, or the possible sale or other disposition, of the whole or any part of the capital, or business undertaking, of the registered bank or associated person;
(c) By the Bank or with the written consent of the Bank –
(i) to the public; or
(ii) to any person who has a proper interest in knowing that the
notice or direction has been given.
(3) Nothing in subsection (1) applies to the disclosure or publication of the
fact that a direction has been given under section 81(1)(c) or (d) or section 81(2)(c)
or (d) for the purpose of giving effect to that direction.

84 Miscellaneous provisions with respect to notices and directions

(1) A notice given under section 79 and a direction given under section 81
shall be deemed to have been given on delivery to the head office, registered office
or principal place of business in Niue of the registered bank or associated person.
(2) Where the Bank approves the sale or other disposition under section
80 of the whole or any part of the capital, or business undertaking, of a registered
bank or any associated person to any person, the provision of any enactment
requiring any consent, licence, permission, clearance or other authority shall not
apply in relation to that sale or disposition.

85 Financial year

PART 8
FINANCIAL AND OTHER MATTERS
The Bank’s financial year shall end on 30 June in each year or on such other date as the Board may decide.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1325

86 Notional surplus income

For the purposes of section 90 “notional surplus income”, in relation to a
financial year of the Bank, means the gross income of the Bank in that year, after –
(a) Deducting the amount of income estimated to be paid or applied
in meeting the expenditure (other than interest expenditure) of the
Bank in carrying out the functions and exercising the powers
referred to in section 87(1) –
(i) as determined under the relevant funding agreement; or
(ii) if a funding agreement has not been ratified under section 89,
as determined under the funding agreement applying to the
immediately preceding financial year;
(b) Deducting the expenditure (other than interest expenditure)
incurred by the Bank in respect of that year in carrying out the other
functions of the Bank;
(c) Deducting interest expenditure incurred by the Bank in carrying
out any of its functions;
(d) Deducting any provision made under generally accepted
accounting practice (other than those taken into account under
paragraphs (a) and (b));
(e) Deducting any net income derived by the Bank from its other
functions as shown in the financial statements of the Bank for that
financial year;
(f) Adding any net loss incurred by the Bank from its other functions
as shown in the financial statements of the Bank for that financial
year.

87 Funding agreements

(1) Funding agreements shall be entered into by the Minister and the Board
which shall specify the amount of income of the Bank to be paid or applied in
meeting the expenditure incurred by the Bank in each financial year in carrying
out the functions imposed and exercising the powers conferred by this Act and
any other Act.
(2) There shall be a funding agreement applying for every financial year
and each funding agreement shall apply to a period that comprises 3 consecutive
financial years.
(3) The Minister and the Board may by agreement –
(a) Vary the provisions of a funding agreement; or
(b) Terminate a funding agreement and enter into a new funding
agreement.

88 Contents of funding agreements

Every funding agreement shall be in writing and –
(a) Shall make provision for the total expenditure to be incurred by
the Bank in carrying out the functions and exercising the powers
specified in section 87(1);
(b) Shall make provision for such items as may under generally
accepted accounting practice, properly be taken into account in
determining the expenditure applicable to those functions and
powers;
(c) May provide for the extent, if any, to which any material change in
the nature or extent of the work undertaken by the Bank in respect
of any of those functions or powers shall require the total level of
expenditure to be redetermined between the Board and the Minister;
1326 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(d) May make provision for such other matters, not being matters that are inconsistent with this section, as the Board and the Minister may think fit.

89 Funding agreements to be ratified by the Assembly

(1) On the sitting day immediately following a funding agreement being
entered into, or a funding agreement being varied, the Minister shall lay a copy of
the agreement or the variation before the Assembly.
(2) No funding agreement, and no variation of a funding agreement, shall
be effective for the purposes of this Act unless it is ratified by a resolution of the
Assembly.

90 Application of surplus income

(1) The amount by which, in any financial year, the actual net income of
the Bank as shown the financial statements of the Bank for that year exceeds the
notional surplus income for that year, calculated under section 86, shall be paid or
credited to the reserves of the Bank.
(2) The amount by which in any financial year the notional surplus income
for that year, calculated under section 86, exceeds the actual net income of the
Bank for that year, as shown in the financial statements of the Bank for that year,
shall be deducted from the reserves of the Bank.
(3) An amount equal to the amount of the notional surplus income
calculated under section 86 for each financial year shall be paid or credited, at the
direction of the Minister, after consultation with the Bank –
(a) To the reserves of the Bank or to the Niue Government Account; or
(b) To both the reserves of the Bank and to the Niue Government
Account in proportions determined by the Minister after
consultation with the Bank.
(4) In determining the amount of the notional surplus income to be credited
to the reserves of the Bank, the Minister shall have regard to –
(a) The capital requirements of the Bank; and
(b) The views of the Board; and
(c) Any other relevant matters.

91 Annual report and accounts

(1) Within 6 months after the end of each financial year the Bank shall
deliver to the Minister –
(a) A report on the operations of the Bank during that financial year;
(b) Audited financial statements for that financial year;
(c) The auditor ’s report on those financial statements;
(d) A statement of the projected income and expenditure for the next
financial year.
(2) The report referred to in subsection (1)(a) shall contain such information
as is necessary to enable an informed assessment to be made of the Bank’s
performance in carrying out its functions during that year.
(3) The documents referred to in subsection (1) shall, by virtue of this
section, stand referred to the Assembly.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1327

92 Contents of financial statements

(1) The financial statements shall be prepared under generally accepted
accounting practice and shall include –
(a) A statement of the Bank’s financial position as at its balance date;
(b) An operating statement reflecting the income and expenses of the
Bank for that year by reference to the functions carried out by the
Bank;
(c) A statement of cash flows reflecting the Bank’s cash flow for that
year;
(d) A statement of the Bank’s commitments as at the balance date;
(e) A statement of the Bank’s contingent liabilities as at the balance
date;
(f) A statement of accounting policies;
(g) Such other statements as are necessary to fairly reflect the financial
operations of the Bank for that year and its financial position at the
end of that year;
(h) Comparative actual figures for the previous financial year for
paragraphs (a) to (e) and, where appropriate paragraph (g).
(2) The financial statements shall show separately–
(a) Any payments made by the Bank under section 8(1); and
(b) Any payments made by the Minister to the Bank under section 8(2).

93 Management statements

(1) The financial statements of the Bank shall be accompanied by a
management statement signed by the Board.
(2) The management statement shall comprise –
(a) A statement of the management’s responsibility for the preparation
of the annual financial statements and the judgments used in them;
(b) A statement of the management’s responsibility for establishing and
maintaining a system of internal control designed to provide
reasonable assurance as to the integrity and reliability of financial
reporting;
(c) A statement that, in the opinion of the management, the annual
financial statements for the financial year fairly reflect the financial
position and operations of the Bank.

94 Auditors

(1) The Minister may appoint one or more persons (whether as individuals
or as the members of any firm or firms), being persons qualified for appointment
as auditors of a company under the Companies Act 1955 (NZ) or Companies Act
1993 (NZ) to be the auditor or auditors of the Bank.
(2) Every appointment shall be for a term not exceeding 2 years, but any
person appointed as auditor shall continue in office until a successor comes into
office.
(3) Any person appointed as auditor shall be eligible for reappointment. (4) The auditor or auditors shall be entitled to receive from the funds of
the Bank such fees as the Board determines.
1328 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

95 Performance audit

(1) Cabinet on the advice of the Minister may appoint one or more persons
(whether as individuals or as members of any firm or firms) to carry out an
assessment of the performance by the Bank of its functions and of the exercise by
the Bank of its powers under this Act.
(2) As soon as practicable after completing an assessment, the person
appointed shall submit a report to the Minister setting out the results of that
assessment.
(3) The report shall by virtue of this section, stand referred to the Assembly.
(4) Any person appointed to conduct an assessment under this section,
for the purpose of conducting that assessment –
(a) Shall have full access to all books and documents that are the
property of or that are under the control of any person relating to
the Bank or its affairs;
(b) May require any director, officer or employee of the Bank or any
other person to answer any questions relating to the Bank or its
affairs;
(c) May, by notice in writing to any person, require that person to
deliver any books or documents relating to the Bank or its affairs in
the possession or under the control of that person and may take
copies of them or extracts from them.
(5) Nothing in subsection (4) limits or affects section 74.
(6) The fees of the person appointed to carry out an assessment under this
section shall be paid out of the funds of the Bank.
PART 9
INTERNATIONAL COMMERCIAL BANK

96 Bank to act as International Commercial Bank

The Bank shall act as an International Commercial Bank under this Part.

97 Appointment of Board of International Commercial Bank

(1) The Board shall, on the advice of the Cabinet, appoint a board to
administer the functions and powers of the International Commercial Bank.
(2) This board shall be known as the International Commercial Bank Board.
(3) The International Commercial Bank Board shall consist of 3 members.
(4) The International Commercial Bank Board shall comprise –
(a) A Chief Executive to be appointed by Cabinet;
(b) Two non-executive directors to be appointed by Cabinet on the
advice of the Minister;
(5) A member of the Board of the Niue Bank shall not be a member of the
International Commercial Bank Board at any one time.
(6) The members of the International Commercial Bank Board shall be
deemed officers of the Bank for the purposes of section 73 and directors for the
purposes of section 106.
(7) Sections 24 to 31 shall apply to the operations and membership of the
International Commercial Bank Board.

Niue Bank Act 1994

1329

98 Duties of Board of International Commercial Bank

Subject to this Act, the International Commercial Bank Board shall –
(a) Keep under constant review the performance of the International
Commercial Bank in carrying out its functions;
(b) Ensure that the International Commercial Bank carries out the
functions imposed on it by this Act;
(c) Ensure that the resources of the International Commercial Bank are
properly and effectively managed;
(d) Direct the exercise of the powers granted to the International
Commercial Bank by this Act.

99 Powers of the International Commercial Bank

(1) The International Commercial Bank shall have the power to enter into
such transactions as the Board determines are for the benefit of Niue.
(2) The International Commercial Bank shall have all the powers associated
with a commercial bank including the following –
(a) The power to incorporate and/or register a company; and
(b) The power to give security over its assets and undertaking.
(3) In discharging its functions under section 96, the International
Commercial Bank may exercise those powers specified in sections 7 to 19 if the
Board gives its prior consent to such exercise.

100 Liabilities of International Commercial Bank not to be charge against the Niue Government Account

(1) Any liability or obligation incurred by the International Commercial Bank as a result of performing its duties or exercising any power under this Act shall not be a charge against the Niue Government Account.
(2) The Government Loans Act 1980 shall not apply to any liability or obligation incurred by the International Commercial Bank as a result of performing its duties or exercising any power under this Act.

101 Issue of Bank notes

PART 10
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
(1) It shall not be lawful for any Bank to issue bank notes in Niue.
(2) Any person who contravenes subsection (1) commits an offence and is
liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty units.

102 Obligations under this Act not limited

An obligation or limitation imposed on a person by any other Act or
instrument or by any trust or agreement shall not prevent or excuse that person
from complying with any provision of this Act or any regulation made under it or
with any direction, notice, requirement or condition given or imposed under that
provision.
1330 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

103 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations for all or any of the following purposes –
(a) Providing for those Acts to be administered by the Bank under
section 6;
(b) Providing for such matters as are necessary to enable the Minister
or the Bank to exercise any powers and functions conferred on the
Minister or the Bank by this Act or by any regulation made for any
of the purposes of this Act;
(c) Providing for the granting, refusal and revocation of consents,
permissions and exemptions in respect of any matters to which any
regulations made under this Act relate; and authorising the
imposition, variation, and revocation of conditions subject to which
such consents, permissions and exemptions may be granted;
(d) Providing for the furnishing of information and the production of
books or documents to the Minister or the Bank or any other person
for any of the purposes of any such regulations (whether or not the
effect of doing so may be to require the furnishing of information,
or the production of books or documents, that will reveal the identity
or affairs or any particular person); and providing for the verification
of any such information; and providing that any such books or
documents may be copied, and may be retained or impounded, by
any person or persons to whom they are produced;
(e) Authorising the Minister or the Bank or any other person to exercise
any discretionary power or authority for the purposes of any such
regulations;
(f) Providing for the delegation of any of the powers or functions of
the Minister (including the power of delegation) or the Bank under
any such regulations;
(g) Providing for and regulating the issue, registration, transfer, control
and redemption of any securities issued by the Bank;
(h) Prescribing forms for the purposes of this Act or of any such
regulations, in any case where a form is not prescribed by this Act;
(i) Providing for and regulating the giving or service of notices for the
purposes of this Act or of any such regulations, and the effect of
such notices;
(j) Prescribing fees to be charged by the Bank in respect of any matter
under this Act;
(k) Prescribing offences against any such regulations and prescribing
fines not exceeding in respect of any such offence 500 penalty units
and, in the case of a continuing offence, 5 penalty units for every
day on which the offence has continued;
(l) Providing for such matters as are contemplated by or necessary for
giving full effect to this Act and its due administration.

104 Consents under regulations

(1) If a transaction is entered into or an instrument is executed without the
prior consent of the Minister or the Bank required by any regulations made under
this Act, the Minister or the Bank, as the case may be, may at any time consent to
the entry into the transaction or the execution of the instrument.
(2) Subject to the terms of the consent any transaction or instrument and
any relationship or interests created by it which would be invalid or unenforceable
without that consent shall, on the giving of that consent, be valid and enforceable

Niue Bank Act 1994

1331
as if the consent had been given before the transaction was entered into or the instrument executed.
(3) Consent may be given –
(a) In respect of such transactions, instruments, or persons or classes
of transactions, instruments or persons as the Minister or the Bank
may determine or in respect of any specified transaction, instrument
or person;
(b) Wholly or partly and either unconditionally or subject to such
conditions as the Minister or the Bank thinks fit.
(4) A consent to the entry into any transaction or the execution of any
instrument shall be deemed to be a consent given under the regulations requiring
consent.

105 Offences against regulations

(1) Every person commits an offence against this Act who –
(a) With intent to deceive, makes any false or misleading statement or
any material omission in –
(i) any offer or declaration made for the purposes of any
regulations under this Act; or
(ii) any communication with, or application to, the Minister or the
Bank or any other person (whether in writing or otherwise) for
the purposes of those regulations;
(b) Resists, obstructs, or deceives any person who is exercising or
attempting to exercise any power or function under any such
regulations;
(c) Without lawful excuse, acts in contravention of or fails to comply
in any respect with any such regulations or any direction, notice,
requirement or condition given or imposed under any such
regulations.
(2) Nothing in subsection (1) limits section 103(k).

106 Penalties for offences

Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no penalty
is provided except in this section is liable on conviction –
(a) In the case of an individual to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
3 months or to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units;
(b) In the case of a body corporate, to a fine not exceeding 500 penalty
units.

107 Evidence

(1) A copy of a resolution of the Bank certified by the Board to be correct
shall in the absence of proof to the contrary be sufficient evidence of the resolution
in any proceedings.
(2) A certificate signed by the Board to the effect that –
(a) Any approval or consent required under any Act has or has not
been given by the Bank, or is or is not for the time being in force; or
(b) Any document has been duly signed by or on behalf of the Bank or
the Board –
shall in the absence of proof to the contrary be sufficient evidence of the matters
stated in it in any proceedings.
(3) Any certificate purporting to have been signed by the Board shall, in
the absence of proof to the contrary, be deemed for all purposes to have been duly
signed by the Board.

1332 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

108 No action to lie against certain persons

Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, no action shall lie against the Government, the Minister, the Bank, the Board, or any director or employee of the Bank in respect of the performance of their functions or duties under this Act.

109 [Spent]

1333

NIUE CERTIFICATION AUTHORITY ACT 1978

1978/36 – 14 February 1978

1

Short title

5

Functions of Authority

2

Interpretation

6

Use of common seal

3

Niue Certification Authority established

7

Regulations

4

Meetings

8

Expenses of Authority

To establish the Niue Certification Authority and to define its functions and powers

1 Short title

This is the Niue Certification Authority Act 1978.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Authority” means the Niue Certification Authority established under
section 3;
“Minister” means the Minister for Education;
“trade” means any trade in connection with which the Authority considers
it desirable to conduct examinations or issue certificates.

3 Niue Certification Authority established

(1) There is hereby established for the purposes of this Act the Niue
Certification Authority.
(2) The Authority shall consist of –
(a) The Secretary to the Government, who shall be the Chairman;
(b) The Director of Public Works;
(c) The Director of Education;
(d) Two other officers appointed for a period of 3 years by the Cabinet.

4 Meetings

(1) Meetings of the Board shall be held at such time and places as the
Authority or the Chairman determines.
(2) A quorum shall consist of 3 members of the Authority.
(3) Every question before the Authority shall be determined by a majority
of the votes of the members present at a meeting of the Authority.
(4) As often as the office is vacant the Authority shall appoint a Deputy
Chairman who shall hold office, while he continues to be a member of the Authority,
for a term of 3 years, and who may be reappointed.
1334 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(5) (a) The Chairman shall preside at all meetings at which he is present. (b) In the absence of the Chairman from any meeting the Deputy
Chairman shall preside.
(c) In the absence of both the Chairman and Deputy Chairman from
any meeting the members present shall appoint one of their number
to preside at that meeting.
(6) The person presiding at any meeting of the Authority shall have a
deliberative vote and, in the case of an equality of votes, shall have a casting vote.
(7) Except as expressly provided in this Act or in regulations under this
Act, the Authority may regulate its procedure in such manner as it thinks fit.

5 Functions of Authority

(1) The functions of the Authority shall be –
(a) To make provision for the examination of persons practising or
intending to practise any trade calling or profession who desire to
present themselves for examination;
(b) To make provisions for the examination of public servants who are
studying for the Niue Public Service Administration Certificate and
who desire to present themselves for examination;
(c) To grant or issue diplomas or certificates of his proficiency in any
trade, calling or matter relating to any trade calling or profession;
(d) To grant or issue diplomas or certificates to any public servant who
has satisfied the course requirements for the Niue Public Service
Administration Certificate.
(2) The Authority may expand any moneys and generally take any action
for any purpose that in its opinion is ancillary to its functions as defined in
subsection (1). Without limiting the general power conferred under subsection (1)
it is hereby declared that the Authority may –
(a) Co-opt, if necessary, any person or persons to advise the Authority
in connection with any of its functions under subsection (1);
(b) With the approval of Cabinet, appoint such Advisory or Technical
Committee to advise the Authority on such matters within the scope
of its functions and powers as are referred to them by the Authority,
and appoint any person to be a member of any such Committee,
notwithstanding that he is not a member of the Authority;
(c) Charge fees for entry for examination.

6 Use of common seal

The common seal of the Authority shall not be affixed to any document,
other than a diploma or certificate issued by the Authority, except under a
resolution of the Authority, and the fixing of the seal to any such document shall
be attested by the Minister and the Chairman.

7 Regulations

Cabinet may make all such regulations that may be necessary or expedient
for giving full effect to this Act and for the due administration of it.

8 Expenses of Authority

All payments made in the course of the administration of this Act shall be
made out of money which the Authority receives in exercise of its functions from
fees and otherwise, and, to the extent that money is insufficient, shall be made out
of money appropriated by the Assembly for the purposes of the Department of
Education.
1335

NIUE CULTURAL COUNCIL ACT 1986

1986/109 – 16 June 1986

1

Short title

7

Annual Report

2

Interpretation

8

Use of the common seal

3

Establishment of the Niue Cultural Council

9

Regulations

4

Functions of the Council

10

Expenses of the Council

5

Meetings

6

Officers

To establish the Niue Cultural Council to promote all aspects of work connected with the natural history and material culture of Niue and to define the functions and powers of the Council

1 Short title

This is the Niue Cultural Council Act 1986.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Council” means the Niue Cultural Council established under section 3;
“historic site” means a location of significant historic connections, often
associated with a famous person or persons or event;
“oral tradition” interprets as an expression of all signs, spoken or gestural,
musical or visual, produced by man within the given culture.

3 Establishment of Niue Cultural Council

(1) There is hereby established for the purposes of this Act a Niue Cultural
Council.
(2) The Council shall consist of –
(a) A Chairman; and
(b) Four other members appointed by Cabinet.
(3) At least 2 members of the Council shall not be members of the Niue
Public Service.
(4) Except as otherwise provided in this Act, every member of the Council
shall be appointed for a term of 3 years and may be reappointed for a like term.
(5) Any member of the Council may at any time be removed from office
by Cabinet for disability, neglect of duty or misconduct proved to the satisfaction
of Cabinet, or may, at any time, by written notice delivered to Cabinet regarding
that member ’s office.
(6) Any member of the Council who ceases permanently to reside in Niue
shall, upon such cessation, be deemed to have resigned from office.
(7) If any member of the Council dies or otherwise ceases to be a member
of the Council, Cabinet shall appoint some other person to be a member of the
Council for the balance of the term for which the vacating member of the Council
was appointed.
1336 Niue Laws 2006 Vol3
(8) Every member of the Council, unless that member sooner ceases to be a member of the Council otherwise than by effluxion of time, shall continue to hold office as a member of the Council until a successor comes into office, notwithstanding that the term for which that member was appointed may have expired.
(9) In any case in which Cabinet is satisfied that any member of the Council
is temporarily incapacitated by reason for illness, temporary absence from Niue
or other sufficient cause from performing the duties of his office, Cabinet may in
writing appoint a deputy to act for such member during the incapacity of such
member, and any such deputy shall, whilst acting as such, be deemed another
member of the Council, as the case may be; and no such appointment of a deputy
and no acts done by a deputy as such shall, in any proceedings or otherwise, be
questioned on the grounds that the occasion of the appointment has not arisen or
has ceased.

4 Functions of the Council

(1) The functions of the Council shall be –
(a) To promote all aspects of work connected with culture and
technology including documentation, conservation and repatriation
of artifacts;
(b) To encourage and foster the study of oral traditions, language and
creative and performing arts in their traditional and contemporary
forms;
(c) To encourage the promotion of salvage archaeology and the
conservation of archaeological materials, sites and monuments; and
(d) To regulate and control the use and development of historic sites.
(2) Without limiting the general power in subsection (1), it is hereby
declared that the Council may –
(a) Co-opt, if necessary, any person or persons to advise the Council in
connection with any of its functions under subsection (1);
(b) Appoint such Advisory or Technical Committee to advise the
Council on such matters within the scope of its functions and powers
as referred to them by the Council, and appoint any person to be a
member of any such Committee, notwithstanding that such person
shall not be a member of the Council.

5 Meetings

(1) The meetings of the Council shall be held at such time and places as
the Council or the Chairman of it determines.
(2) At all the meetings of the Council, 3 members of the Council shall form
a quorum.
(3) As often as the office is vacant, the Council shall appoint a Deputy
Chairman who shall hold office whilst still a member of the Council, and who
may be reappointed.
(4) (a) The Chairman shall preside at all its meetings.
(b) In the absence of the Chairman from any meeting the Deputy
Chairman shall preside.
(c) In the absence of both the Chairman and Deputy Chairman from
any meting, the members present shall appoint one of their number
to preside at that meeting.
(5) The person presiding at any meeting of the Council shall have a
deliberate vote and, in the case of an equality of votes, shall have a casting vote.

Niue Cultural Council Act 1986

1337
(6) All operations before the Council shall be determined by a majority of the votes of the members present at a meeting of the Council.
(7) The Council shall cause minutes to be made in a book or books provided for that purpose.

6 Officers

There may be appointed by the Niue Public Service Commissioner such
officers considered necessary to assist the Council in carrying out its functions
and representatives.

7 Annual Report

The Council shall be responsible to and shall report to the Government
annually through the Minister in charge of Cultural Affairs.

8 Use of the common seal

The common seal of the Council shall not be affixed to any document,
writing or other instrument except in the presence of at least 3 members of the
Council, and all the members of the Council present when such seal is affixed
shall sign the document, writing or other instrument to which such seal is affixed.

9 Regulations

Cabinet may make all such regulations that may in its opinion be necessary
or expedient for giving full effect to this Act and for the due administration of it.

10 Expenses of the Council

All payments made in the course of the administration of this Act shall be
made out of money which the Council receives in exercise of its functions from
fees and otherwise, and, to the extent that money is insufficient, shall be made out
of money appreciated by the Assembly for the purposes of the Council.

1338 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1339

NIUE DEVELOPMENT BANK ACT 1993

1994/189 – 6 July 1994

PART 4

ACCOUNTS AND REPORTS

25 Financial year

26 Accounts and audit

27 Reports

PART 5

SECURITIES

28 Security for advances

29 Securities to be taken in name of Bank

30 Assignment of money as security may be

irrevocable

31 Alienation and assignment as security for

advances

32 Assignments of money from land vested

in trustees

33 Advances to be paid as Bank directs

34 Charging order may be made

35 Discharging of charging orders

36 Appointment of receiver to enforce

charges

37 Taxation

PART 6

MISCELLANEOUS

38 Contracts of Bank

39 Execution of documents

40 Evidence of documents

41 Penalty for misapplication of loan

42 False statements

43 Disclosure of information

44 Breach of Act or regulations

45 Rules

46 Regulations

47-49 [Spent]

To establish the Niue Development Bank

1 Short title

This is the Niue Development Bank Act 1993.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Audit Office” means the auditor appointed under article 60 of the
Constitution;
1340 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“Bank” means the Niue Development Bank;
“economic development” means development, in conformity with the
priorities of national development goals made by the Government
including development of –
(a) Tourism;
(b) Agriculture, livestock, forestry and fishing;
(c) Manufacturing and processing industries;
(d) Engineering, construction and transport;
(e) Commercial activities;
(f) Housing;
(g) Other areas;
“financial assistance” means any –
(a) Equity participation; or
(b) Loan; or
(c) Hire Purchasing; or
(d) Leasing;
“Minister” means the Minister of Finance;
“permanent Niuean resident” means any person who has been granted
permanent resident status under section 6 of the Entry Residence and
Departure Act 1985;
“recipient” means any Government corporate body, or person, or
organisation, to whom the bank provides financial assistance.
PART 1
ESTABLISHMENT AND ADMINISTRATION

3 Niue Development Bank

(1) There is hereby established a Bank called the Niue Development Bank.
(2) The Bank shall be a body corporate with perpetual succession and a
common seal and shall be capable of acquiring holding and disposing of real and
personal property, suing and being sued and subject to this Act, of doing and
suffering all such other acts and things as body corporates may lawfully do and
suffer.

4 Constitution of Board

(1) There shall be a Board of Directors of the Bank consisting of –
(a) The Financial Secretary or a person delegated by him in writing as
his alternate;
(b) Four persons from the private sector, of good character and standing,
who shall each have expertise in one or more different areas of the
Bank’s operation and who shall be appointed by Cabinet, but shall
not include any Ministers of the Crown or any members of the
Assembly.
(2) Cabinet shall appoint a Chairman who shall be one of the directors
referred to in subsection (1).
(3) The appointment of directors and Chairman shall be publicly notified
in such manner as Cabinet deems appropriate.
(4) The Board may elect one of their members to be Deputy Chairman.
(5) No person shall be deemed to be employed in the public service by
reason only of his being a member of the Board.

Niue Development Bank Act 1993

1341

5 Responsibilities of directors

(1) The Board of Directors shall be responsible to the Cabinet for the proper
and efficient operation of the Bank.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the responsibilities of
the Board of Directors shall include the responsibility to –
(a) Ensure that the functions of the Bank are carried out efficiently and
under proper banking standards;
(b) Maintain the independence and integrity of the Bank;
(c) Ensure that the Bank complies with this Act, the Bank’s policies
and any directions given to the Bank under section 10.

6 Term of office of directors

(1) Except as otherwise provided by this Act, every appointed director shall
hold office for a period of not less than one year and not more than 2 years
commencing on the date of his appointment provided that any director may be
reappointed for further terms.
(2) A member of the Board who is not an employee of the public service or
any ad-hoc body of the Government shall be paid from the funds of the Bank such
remuneration and allowances as Cabinet may determine.
(3) Notwithstanding any other provision in this Act every member whose
office is terminated by the effluxion of time shall continue to hold office until his
successor is appointed.

7 Extraordinary vacancies

(1) Any appointed director may at any time be removed from office by the
Minister with the concurrence of Cabinet –
(a) For disability, bankruptcy, neglect of duty or misconduct proved to
the satisfaction of the Minister with the concurrence of Cabinet; or
(b) If that director is absent from Niue for any period exceeding 2
months; or
(c) If the director is absent from 3 consecutive meetings of the Board
without leave of absence from the Board.
(2) An appointed director may at any time resign his office by delivering a
notice in writing to that effect to Cabinet.
(3) If any director dies or resigns, or is removed from office, his office shall
become vacant and the vacancy shall be deemed to be an extraordinary vacancy.
(4) An extraordinary vacancy shall be filled by the appointment of a person
in the same manner as the appointment of the vacating member.
(5) Every person appointed to fill an extraordinary vacancy shall be
appointed for the residue of the term for which the vacating member was
appointed.
(6) The powers of the Board shall not be affected by any vacancy in its
membership, provided that no business shall be transacted by the board if at any
time its total membership under clause 4 falls below 3 persons.

8 Meetings of the Board

(1) The first meeting of the Board shall be held on a day to be appointed by
the Minister.
(2) Subsequent meetings of the Board shall be held at intervals of not more
than every 6 weeks, at such times and places as the Board appoints.
(3) The Minister, or the Chairman or any 2 directors may at any time call a
special meeting of the Board.
1342 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(4) Not less than 3 days notice of every meeting, together with the proposed agenda for that meeting shall be given in writing to every director present in Niue, unless all the directors of the time being in Niue unanimously agree that shorter notice may be given in respect of any particular meeting.
(5) At all meetings of the Board the quorum necessary for the transaction of business other than the adjournment of the meeting shall be not less than 3 members holding office.
(6) The Chairman shall preside at all meetings of the Board at which he is present.
(7) In the absence of the Chairman from any meeting, the Vice-Chairman shall preside, provided that if the Vice-Chairman is also absent, then the directors present shall appoint one of their number to be Chairman.
(8) At any meeting of the Board every director shall be entitled to one vote on any matter, provided that the Chairman or other person presiding shall in the case of equality of votes, also have a casting vote.
(9) Minutes shall be kept of every meeting of the Board. A resolution in writing signed or assented to by letter or facsimile, by all members of the Board shall be as valid and effectual as if it had been passed at a meeting of the Board duly called and constituted.
(10) Subject to this Act and of any regulations under it, the Board may regulate its procedures in such manner as it thinks fit.
(11) (a) No director shall vote or take part in the discussion of any matter before the Board or before the committee of it in which he has directly or indirectly a pecuniary interest apart from any interest in common with the public.
(b) Any director who knowingly offends against this subsection commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units.

9 Committees

(1) The Board may by resolution appoint, discharge, alter, continue or
reconstitute a committee or committees, consisting of 2 or more members, to advise
the Board on such matters as are referred to any committee by the Board.
(2) Any person may be appointed to be a member of any committee
appointed under this section notwithstanding that he is not a member of the Board.
(3) Subject to this Act, of any regulations, or of any general or special
directives of the Board, any such committee may regulate its procedure in such
manner as it thinks fit.

10 Directives by Cabinet

(1) Cabinet may give the Bank in writing such directives as Cabinet thinks
fit as to the policy to be followed by the Bank in the exercise of its functions or
powers, provided that no such directives shall be given in respect of specific loans
or loan applications.
(2) The Bank shall, in the exercise of its functions and powers, give effect
to any written directives given to it by the Cabinet under this section.
(3) A copy of every direction given by Cabinet to the bank under this section
in any financial year shall be included in the annual report of the Bank for that
year laid before the Assembly under section 27(1)(b).

Niue Development Bank Act 1993

1343

11 General Manager and other employees

(1) The Board shall employ at such remuneration and on such terms and
conditions as it may determine, a suitably qualified General Manager, who shall perform such duties as may be prescribed by the Board.
(2) The General Manager may be required to attend all Board meetings unless his presence at any meeting is excused by the Board or when any matter in which he is directly or indirectly privately interested is to be considered at such meeting.
(3) The Board may engage at such remuneration on such terms and
conditions and in such number as it may determine, other employees as may be
essential for the conduct of the business of the Bank.
(4) The Board may in writing delegate to the General Manager or other
employee of the Bank such of the powers or functions of the Board including the
power of delegation conferred by this section as it may think fit; provided that in
no case shall any power –
(i) to acquire land or buildings; or
(ii) to sell land or building vested in the Bank be delegated.
(5) Subject to any general or special direction given or conditions imposed
by the Board or person to whom any powers are delegated as aforesaid, any person
to whom any powers are delegated may exercise those powers in the same manner
and with the same effect as if they had been conferred directly by this Act and not
by delegation.
(6) Every person purporting to act under any delegation under this section
shall be presumed to be acting under the terms of the delegation in the absence of
proof to the contrary.
(7) Any delegation under this section may be made to a specified person
or to persons of a specified class or may be made to the holder for the time being
of a specified office or appointment or to the holders of offices or appointments of
a special class.
(8) Any delegation under this section may be revoked at any time.
(9) The delegation of any power by the Board or person shall not prevent
the exercise of that power by the Board or as the case may require, by that person.
(10) A copy of every delegation made under this section in any financial
year shall be included in the annual report of the bank for that year laid before the
Assembly under section 27(1)(b).
(11)Any person in the public service may be appointed to be an officer or
employee of the Bank but no such person shall be entitled to hold office
concurrently as an officer or employee of the Bank and as a public servant except –
(a) In the case of a person who is a member of the public service with
the consent of the Public Service Commission; and
(b) In any other case with the consent of the Minister of the Crown to
whose control he is subject.
(12)(a) Any person who was an officer of the public service and who is
employed by the Bank, may within 3 months after his appointment
as an officer or employee of the Bank, elect to resume employment
in the public service and, in any such case, notwithstanding the
provisions of any enactment to the contrary, his employment in the
public service shall be deemed to have continued without
interruption;
(b) This subsection shall not apply to any person whose employment
by the Bank is terminated for misconduct or neglect of duty.
1344 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(c) No person shall be entitled to receive any salary as a member of the public service in respect of any period during which he was employed by the Bank.

12 Consultant and specialist personnel

Without limiting this Act, the board may with the approval of the Minister
with concurrence of Cabinet appoint consultants, advisers and such specialist
personnel as it thinks necessary or appropriate to assist the General Manager or
the Bank generally or specifically.

13 Personal liability

No member of the Board or employee of the Bank shall be personally liable
for any act or default done or made by the Board or by any director or employee
in good faith in the course of the operations of the Bank.

14 Authorised capital

(1) [Spent]
PART 2
CAPITAL
(2) The authorised capital of the Board may be increased to such amount as may be prescribed by Cabinet.
(3) The authorised capital of the Bank shall not be increased otherwise than under this section.

15 Subscription of shares

(1) The Bank shall not allot any of its unissued shares to any person other
than Her Majesty or a nominee holding the shares on behalf of Her Majesty.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1) the Minister may hold and subscribe
for shares on behalf of Her Majesty and any statutory body in which the
Government holds a controlling interest or ad hoc of Government may be a
nominee of Her Majesty for the purpose of subscribing for and being allotted
shares on Her behalf.
(3) The shares of the Bank shall not be pledged or encumbered in any
manner whatsoever and shall not without the prior approval of Cabinet be
transferred or assigned and then, only on such terms and conditions as Cabinet
may impose.
(4) The liability of a shareholder shall be limited to the unpaid portion of
the par value of shares for which the shareholder subscribed.
PART 3
FUNCTIONS, POWERS AND FUNDS

16 Functions of the Bank

(1) The general functions of the Bank shall be –
(a) To provide finance for the establishment, development, extension
or assistance of industry and economic development in Niue;
(b) To encourage and promote investment in the economic
development of Niue;
(c) To provide finance for dwellings and improved housing and
improved living conditions in Niue;
(d) To provide technical assistance or advice and to generally foster
economic development in Niue.

Niue Development Bank Act 1993

1345
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the Bank shall have the following functions –
(a) To provide financial assistance on such terms and conditions as the Board thinks fit, to permanent Niuean residents engaged or about to be or intending to be engaged in any economic development in Niue;
(b) To provide such advisory and technical services either with or without remuneration or fee as the Board considers desirable or expedient in the interest of the community and its economic development;
(c) To assist in obtaining and placing foreign investment on Niue for the purposes of economic development;
(d) To administer on such terms and conditions as may be approved by the board such special funds as may be placed at the disposal of the Bank;
(e) To study and promote onshore investment opportunities for the economic development in Niue;
(f) With the prior approval of Cabinet to acquire by lease or sublease
any land or buildings and to develop the same as a building estate
by the erection, construction, alteration, maintenance and
improvement of dwelling houses or flats, and gardens, recreation
parks and other works and buildings for or for the convenience of
persons occupying such dwelling houses or flats;
(g) To lease any land in the cause of housing and other urban
development, improvements and renewal; provided that the power
to sell land contained in here shall not extend to any land acquired
by the Government by warrant under section 8 of the Niue
Amendment Act 1968 No 2 and provided further that this provision
shall not be deemed to extend the powers of the Niue Development
Bank in respect of land beyond such powers as the Niue
Development Bank would have had prior to the passing of this
Act;
(h) To do all matters and things incidental to or connected with the
foregoing.
(3) The Board shall have such other functions as are conferred on it by this
Act or by any other enactment.

17 Powers of the Bank

(1) The Bank shall have all such powers, rights and authorities as may
reasonably be necessary or expedient to carry out its functions.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1) the Board shall have
the following specific powers –
(a) Sell, purchase or subscribe for shares, debentures, bonds or other
securities including securities which the Bank has issued or
guaranteed or make loans, with or without security, or acquire any
other interest;
(b) Finance the purchase, sale or hire of machinery, plant, equipment,
materials, goods and articles of every description by means of any
arrangement whatsoever, including but without limiting the
generality of the foregoing, the purchase and resale and hire of it
on such terms as the Board thinks fit; and
1346 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(c) Execute, make, draw, accept, endorse, discount, issue and negotiate cheques, promissory notes, bills of exchange, bills of lading, bankers and other drafts, warrants, bonds, debentures, coupons and other negotiable or transferable instruments and buy, sell or otherwise deal in the same, and accept deposits of money;
(d) With the prior approval of Cabinet and upon terms and conditions
to be approved by Cabinet, borrow money required by it for the
purpose of meeting any of its obligations of discharging any of its
functions under this Act provided that the aggregate of the liabilities
of the Bank outstanding at any one time, including bonds and
debentures if any, issued by the Bank shall not exceed 3 times the
amount of its paid-up shares capital and reserves;
(e) Participate, in the discretion of the Board, in the management of
enterprises to whose finance it has contributed whether by loan or
otherwise;
(f) Organise, participate in, or act as agent for consortium arrangements
for the assistance of economic development in Niue;
(g) Act as agent for the government of international financial
institutions in the financing of economic development in Niue;
(h) Place funds not immediately required on deposit with any onshore
bank, or an overseas bank with Cabinet’s approval;
(i) Take such steps as may be necessary to protect or recover its financial
interest in any business;
(j) To accept gifts of leases or subleases of any land, money or other
property;
(k) To subdivide or develop any land acquired by or vested in it;
(l) Subject to the provisions of any enactment applicable to the bank,
to fix, regulate or make such charges as may be determined from
time to time for the use of any dwelling house, flat, building or
other facility provided, maintained, controlled or operated by the
bank;
(m) To make advances under this Act;
(n) To negotiate and enter into arrangements with and between
landowners and householders, and assist by advice and otherwise
the development of private housing conditions;
(o) To contract for the execution or provision by any person of any
work or services authorised by this or any other enactment to be
executed or provided by the Board in such manner and subject to
such terms and conditions as the Board thinks fit;
(p) Make such charges for the provision of its service as the Bank thinks
fit.

18 Operating principles

(1) In determining whether or not any financial assistance shall be given
to any enterprise, the Board shall properly evaluate each proposal and consider – (a) The prospects of the enterprises being or becoming and remaining financially viable and the prospects of any money lent to it by the
Bank being repaid to the Bank;
(b) The degree to which the enterprise is or will become or remain of
value to the economy of Niue;
(c) The degree to which persons ordinarily resident in Niue will derive
a direct benefit from the enterprise;
(d) Any policy directives given to it by Cabinet.

Niue Development Bank Act 1993

1347
(2) No financial assistance shall be given in respect of any project, or for housing purposes unless the Board is satisfied –
(a) That the project or recipient has the financial ability and resources to meet all repayments and other obligations imposed by the Bank; or
(b) That the recipient is a permanent Niuean resident or an organisation
in which the majority shareholder or principal partner or owner is
a permanent Niuean resident.

19 Vesting of property in Bank

(1) Her Majesty may in accordance with section 8 of the Niue Amendment
(No 2) Act 1968 grant in respect of the Crown land, any lease, licence, easement or
other limited estate, right or interest to the Bank or in the name of the Bank property,
rights or privileges, vested in or held on behalf of the Crown and used or
administered or to be used or administered for the purposes of or in connection
with any housing or industrial projects or town planning schemes subject to any
leases, rights, easements and interests subsisting in respect of the land or property
at the date of the grant, transfer or assignment.
(2) Any lease by the Crown under subsection (1) may be for such term and
provide for such rent and other conditions as the Bank with the prior written
approval of the Minister shall accept or approve.

20 Funds

(1) The funds of the Bank shall consist of –
(a) Such sums of money as may be received by the Bank under section
15;
(b) Such sums of money as the Bank may acquire by virtue or grants or
raised by way of loan;
(c) Such sums of money as may be appropriated for it by the Assembly;
and
(d) Such other sums of money as may accrue to it in the course and on
account of its business.
(2) Any special funds shall be kept separate from the other funds specified
in subsection (1).
(3) No charge or lien created on any special fund shall operate as a charge
or lien upon the funds of the Bank, provided that –
(a) Where in any Appropriation Act or in any estimate of expenditure
and revenue accompanying the Appropriation Act for any year any
vote or item to which the section applies is noted as being for a
specified purpose, it shall not be competent for the Bank to use
moneys so appropriated for any purpose other than that specified
in such Act or estimate; and,
(b) Where any appropriation is made for the purposes of the Board,
the Cabinet may direct the manner in which the moneys
appropriated shall be paid to the Board and may require that any
such appropriation be used first in payment of any debt due to the
Public Account or to any account within the Public Account.
1348 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

21 Application of funds

The funds of the Bank shall be applied towards –
(a) The payment of salaries and fees due to employees of the Bank;
(b) The repayment of sums raised by way of loan by the bank and the
payment of interest on it;
(c) Providing financial assistance under this Act;
(d) The payment of rates, taxes, insurance premiums and other
outgoings;
(e) The payment of such dividends as the Board may authorise; and
(f) All other payments necessary for or incidental to the business of
the Bank authorised under this Act.

22 Principles and limits on financing and operations

(1) The Bank may alone or in conjunction with other domestic or foreign
investors, provide or participate in providing financial assistance in aid of
development investment in Niue.
(2) In providing financial assistance the Bank shall –
(a) Maintain a reasonable diversification in its investments among all
sectors of economic activity in Niue;
(b) Maintain a satisfactory balance between the dates of maturity or its
own obligations and those of the loans it grants; and
(c) As principal objective, operate as a successful business, as profitably
and efficiently as comparable businesses in the private sector.
(3) The Bank’s financial assistance shall in the cases of a single recipient or
several recipients who are associated with each other in a community of material
financial interest, not exceed 20 per centum of the Bank’s paid-up shares, capital
and reserves.
(4) In the case of funds invested by the Bank in equity participation –
(a) The aggregate of the amounts so invested shall not exceed 20 per
centum of the aggregate of the Bank’s paid-up share capital;
(b) The Bank shall limit such participation, in any recipient or recipients
associated with each other in a community of material financial
interest, to a maximum of 10 per centum of the Bank’s paid up
capital of such recipient; and
(c) The Bank shall seek to rotate its funds by selling such participations
to other investors wherever it can do so on satisfactory terms.

23 Short-term investment

The Bank may invest all or any part of its funds not immediately required
for the purpose stated in this Act in good and sound investment, to be approved
by Cabinet.

24 Reserve Fund and allocation of net profit

(1) The Bank shall provide against any anticipated losses by establishing
and maintaining a reserve fund to which shall be allocated at the end of each
financial year of the Bank –
(a) Not less than 50 per centum of the net profit of the Bank of that
year until the total sum standing to the credit of such reserve fund
shall amount to a sum equal to the paid-up share capital of the
Bank;

Niue Development Bank Act 1993

1349
(b) Not less than 10 per centum of the net profit of the Bank of that year if the total sum standing to the credit of such reserve fund exceeds a sum equal to the paid-up share capital of the Bank.
(2) The Board shall determine annually on the allocation of the net profit of the Bank after providing for the Reserve Fund.

25 Financial Year

PART 4
ACCOUNTS AND REPORTS
The financial year of the Bank shall be the period of 12 months ending on
30 June in each year.

26 Accounts and audit

(1) The Board shall cause true and full accounts and records to be kept of
all the transactions with which the Bank is concerned, and the books of account
and records shall be kept at the principal place of business of the Bank.
(2) The accounts shall be subject to annual audit by the Government’s
official Audit Office or their duly authorised representatives.

27 Reports

(1) The Board shall –
(a) Provide to the Minister a quarterly report containing such financial
and other information as the Minister may require regarding the
operation of the Bank; and
(b) Not later than 3 months after the end of each financial year, submit
to the Cabinet a report of its operations, including the annual
statement of its accounts for that year, and shall forward a copy of
such report and annual statement to the Audit Office;
(c) Submit to Cabinet an audited annual statement of accounts.
(2) Without limiting the content of the annual report required to be made
under subsection (1) under (b) such report shall include the following information –
(a) The objectives and policies of the Bank;
(b) The nature and scope of activities being undertaken or to be
undertaken;
(c) The ratio of capital to total assets, and definitions of those terms as
used in the report;
(d) The accounting policies used in relation to the annual statement
included in the report.
(3) Every audited report and annual report submitted to Cabinet under
subsection (1)(b) and (c) shall forthwith be laid before the Assembly for debate if
the Assembly is then in session, or, if the Assembly is not then in session, within
24 hours of the commencement of the next ensuing session.

28 Security for advances

PART 5
SECURITIES
(1) Advances made by the Bank shall be secured in such manner and on such terms as the Bank thinks fit.
(2) For the purposes of determining whether an application for an advance should be granted, the Bank shall not be bound to insist upon any fixed or definite margin of security.
1350 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

29 Securities to be taken in name of Bank

Every security for an advance shall be taken in the name of the Bank.

30 Assignment of money as security may be irrevocable

(1) The Bank may require any order on or assignment of money given as
security for the repayment of any advance to be expressed to be irrevocable,
notwithstanding the death of the person giving the order or assignment, and the
order or assignment shall be irrevocable accordingly except with the consent in
writing of the Bank.
(2) Notwithstanding anything in any enactment to the contrary, any
company, corporate body, or person upon whom any notice of any such order or
assignment has been served, shall be bound to accept and to act upon the order or
assignment and to pay to the person nominated in that behalf in the order or
assignment all money payable under it.

31 Alienation and assignment as security for advances

(1) Notwithstanding anything in Part 19 of the Niue Act 1966, or in section
24 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968, it shall be competent for any Niuean
or descent of a Niuean to alienate any Niuean freehold land or things growing on
or attached to any such land of the rents and profits from any such land as security
for any advance made by the Bank for any housing or other purpose.
(2) Notwithstanding anything in the Property Law Act 1952 no power of
sale shall be contained or implied in any charge given on any interest in land (not
being leasehold interest) to secure the repayment of any advance made by the
Bank for any housing or other purpose.

32 Assignments of money from land vested in trustees

(1) For the purpose of securing the repayment of any advance made by
the Bank for any housing or other purpose, it shall be competent for any Niuean
or descendant of a Niuean to give an order on or an assignment of the proceeds of
the alienation of any land (including compensation money for land taken) whether
the land is vested in a trustee or not.
(2) Any such order or assignment shall be valid and enforceable for all
purposes notwithstanding any other enactment.

33 Advances to be paid as Bank directs

Every advance shall be expended or applied by the Bank, or at its discretion,
for any one or more purposes for the benefit or on behalf of the applicant and,
unless the Bank otherwise determines, shall not be paid direct to the applicant.

34 Charging order may be made

(1) Notwithstanding anything in the Niue Act 1966, or in any other
enactment where a charge on any interest in land has been given as security for
the repayment of any advance, the Court, on proof to its satisfaction that the
advance has been approved by the Bank, and in anticipation of the advance being
made, may make an order changing the land or any interest in it or any part of it
or any undivided or partial interest in it with repayment of the amount advanced
or to be advanced, together with all interest and other monies which may become
payable thereunder and by such instalments and with such directions for giving
effect to the charge as the Court thinks expedient.

Niue Development Bank Act 1993

1351
(2) The certificate of the Bank shall for all purposes be prima facie proof of the amount of the advance and of the rate of interest payable, and may be accepted by the Court accordingly.
(3) (a) The Court may make a further order varying any former order in respect of any additional advance or by way of apportioning charges in such manner as it thinks expedient or for any other purpose it thinks fit, and every subsequent order shall supersede all prior charging orders so far as it is inconsistent with it.
(b) Where any charge is apportioned, each portion shall be deemed to
be a separate charge.
(4) Every order made under this section shall be registered or recorded, as
the case may require, in such manner as the Court directs.

35 Discharging of charging orders

The Court may at any time, on the application of the Bank wholly or partially
discharge any charging order made under section 34, whether or not the money
secured by the charge has been repaid.

36 Appointment of receiver to enforce charges

(1) When by section 34 any charging order has been made in respect of
any land or any interest or upon the revenues in it or the proceeds of the alienation
of it, the Court may, for the purpose of enforcing that charge, appoint a receiver in
respect of the property so charged.
(2) A receiver appointed under this section shall have all such rights,
powers, duties and liabilities as may be expressly conferred or imposed on him
by the Court and such other incidental powers as may be reasonably necessary
for the exercise of the powers so conferred provided that a receiver appointed
under this section shall not have power to sell the freehold interest in any Niuean
land, or to lease any such land otherwise than as provided in subsection (3).
(3) Notwithstanding any of the provisions of the Niue Act 1966 as to the
alienation of Niuean land, a receiver appointed under this section for the purpose
of enforcing a charge may, in his own name and with the leave of the Court, grant
leases of any land so charged for any term not exceeding 21 years, on such
conditions and for such rent or other consideration as he thinks fit.

37 Taxation

PART 6
MISCELLANEOUS
The income and revenue of the Bank shall not be subject to taxation.

38 Contracts of Bank

(1) Any contract which, if made between private persons must be by deed
shall, if made by the Bank, be in writing under the common seal of the Bank.
(2) Any contract which, if made between private persons, must be in
writing signed by the parties to be charged therewith shall, if made by the Bank
be under the common seal of the Bank.
(3) Any contract which, if made between private persons, may be made
orally may be similarly made by or on behalf of the Bank by any person acting
under its authority, express or implied.
1352 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

39 Execution of documents

(1) Every document to which the common seal of the Bank is affixed shall
be signed by the Chairman or in his absence the Vice-Chairman, and shall be
countersigned by either the General Manager of the Bank, or in his absence from
Niue, any other director.
(2) Any document which, if executed by a private person, would not require
to be executed as a deed may be signed on behalf of the Bank by the Chairman or
by the General Manager of the Bank.
(3) No document to which the common seal is required to be affixed, and
no contract to which the Bank is a party shall be executed except under a resolution
of the directors.

40 Evidence of documents

Every document purporting to be a document executed by or on behalf of
the Bank in a manner provided in section 39 shall be received in evidence and be
deemed to be so executed in the absence of proof to the contrary.

41 Penalty for misapplication of loan

Any person who knowingly applies any loan or part of it made under this
Act to any purpose other than that authorised by the Bank shall be guilty of an
offence and on conviction shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 12 months or to both such fine and
imprisonment.

42 False statements

Any applicant for assistance from the Bank by way of loan or otherwise
who wilfully fails to disclose any material information within his knowledge, or
who wilfully makes any statement which he knows to be false or does not believe
to be true shall be guilty of an offence and on conviction shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 5 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months,
or to both such fine and imprisonment.

43 Disclosure of information

Any Board member or employee of the Bank who directly or indirectly
discloses, or for private purpose uses, any information acquired by him either in
the course of his duties or his capacity as an employee of the Bank shall be guilty
of an offence and on conviction shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty
units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or to both such fine
and imprisonment.

44 Breach of Act or regulations

Every person who commits or attempts to commit or is concerned in
committing or attempting to commit a breach or violation of this Act or of any
regulations made under this Act for which no special penalty is provided is liable
for every offence to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.

45 Rules

The Board may make such rules, consistent with this Act, as it considers
necessary or appropriate to facilitate and control its operations, and further the
objects and functions of the Bank.

Niue Development Bank Act 1993 1353

46 Regulations

Cabinet may by publication in the Gazette after consideration of any recommendations thereon made to it by the Bank through the Minister, make all such regulations as may be necessary or expedient for giving full effect to this Act and for the due administration of it.

47-49 [Spent]

1354 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1355

NIUE DEVELOPMENT BONDS ACT 1994

1994/181 – 28 March 1994

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

5

[Repealed]

1

Short title

6

Prospectus

2

Interpretation

7

Non-resident withholding tax

8

Part of Income Tax Act

PART 2

9

Jurisdiction

NIUE DEVELOPMENT BONDS

10

Secrecy

3

Power to issue Bonds

4

Terms of issue

SCHEDULES

To enable the Niue Bank to borrow money for development purposes by issuing Niue Development Bonds

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Niue Development Bonds Act 1994.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“applicant” means any eligible person making an application for a Bond;
“Bank” means the Niue Bank;
“Bond” means a Niue Development Bond issued under this Act;
“bond certificate” means a bond certificate in the form specified in Schedule
3 issued by the Bank;
“bondholder” means a holder in due course of a Niue Development Bond;
“date of commencement” means the date of receipt by the Bank of an
application plus any payment required by clause 3(4) of Schedule 1;
“date of repayment” means the date on which the Bank is required to make
available the amount of the Bond and any interest required to be paid
under clause 6 of Schedule 1;
“maturity” means the date on which a Bond becomes repayable;
“memorandum of transfer” means a memorandum of transfer inthe form
specified in Schedule 4;
“Minister” means the Minister of Finance;
“non-resident” means a non-resident for the purposes of the Income Tax
Act 1961;
“Register” means the register of Bondholders kept by the Bank under this
Act;
“special terms” means those additional terms of issue approved by Cabinet
in accordance with clause 10 of Schedule 1;
“Treasurer” means the Treasurer as defined in the Income Tax Act 1961.
1356 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 2
NIUE DEVELOPMENT BONDS

3 Power to issue Bonds

(1) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act or any rule of law, the
Bank may, with the approval of Cabinet, issue negotiable fixed or floating rate
coupon bonds if it appears to the Bank to be necessary or expedient in the public
interest to do so.
(2) Any Bonds issued under this Act shall be termed “Niue Development
Bonds”.

4 Terms of issue

(1) The Bonds shall be issued by the Bank under the terms and conditions
of issue specified in Schedule 1 (which shall include any Special Terms approved
by Cabinet in accordance with clause 10 of Schedule 1) as may be amended,
provided that no amendment shall affect the terms of issue of any Bond on issue
at that time until the Bank is renewed.
(2) The Bank shall have the right to amend the terms and conditions of
issue upon written notification to Bondholders of any amendments to the terms
and conditions of issue.
(3) If the Bank notifies existing bondholders of amendments to the terms
and conditions of issue not less than one month prior to the date of repayment,
the amended terms and conditions of issue shall apply for any renewed term
commencing from the date of repayment.
(4) If the Bank fails to notify any amendments to the terms and conditions
of issue within the period specified in subsection (3), the existing terms and
conditions of issue shall apply for any renewed term commencing from the date
of repayment.

5 [Repealed]

6 Prospectus

(1) The Bank shall prior to any issue of Bonds offer them for subscription
by way of registered prospectus.
(2) The prospectus shall be registered with the Minister.
(3) The prospectus shall include the terms and conditions of issue specified
in Schedule 1 (which shall include any Special Terms approved by Cabinet under
clause 10 of Schedule 1).

7 Non-resident withholding tax

(1) Every Non-Resident Bondholder who derives interest on a bond shall
be liable to non-resident withholding tax upon that interest at the domestic tax
rate for resident companies on the gross amount of interest.
(2) Where the Bank makes an interest payment to a Bondholder under this
Act, it shall, at the time of making the payment, make a deduction of non-resident
withholding tax therefrom at the rate referred to in subsection (1).
(3) The Bank, upon making a deduction of non-resident withholding tax,
shall not later than the 20th day of the month next after the month in which the
Bank has made any such deduction, pay to the Treasurer the amount of the
deduction.
(4) The Bank shall not later than the 20th day of the month next after the
month in which the Bank has made a deduction under subsection (2), deliver to
the Treasurer a statement specifying the gross interest payable to the non-resident
Bondholder and any deductions made from it.

Niue Development Bonds Act 1994

1357
(5) The interest payable to the non-resident Bondholder by the Bank shall not be included in the return of assessable income of the non-resident Bondholder and the amount of income tax for which the non-resident Bondholder is liable in respect of the amount of the interest derived by the Bondholder in any income year shall be determined exclusively and finally by the total amount of Non- Resident withholding tax for which the Bondholder is liable by virtue of subsection (1).

8 Part of Income Tax

(1) [Spent]
(2) The non-resident withholding tax imposed by section 7 shall be deemed
to be a tax on assessable income for the purposes of the Income Tax Act 1961.

9 Jurisdiction

The law of Niue shall apply unless expressly excluded by this Act.

10 Secrecy

(1) Except where the provisions of this Act require, it shall be an offence
for any person to divulge or communicate to any other person information relating
to the establishment, constitution, business, undertaking or affairs of an applicant
or Bondholder.
(2) An offence proved to have been committed under this section shall be
liable upon conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 1 year, or to a
fine not exceeding 100 penalty units, or both.
(3) Notwithstanding subsection (1), an offence shall not be committed
where information is divulged or made available to the extent reasonably required
in the circumstances to any foreign Government or any court or tribunal of any
country including Niue but only if and to the extent that the Court so directs,
having been satisfied that the information is required and will be used solely for
the purposes of an investigation or prosecution of any person in relation to the
sale, or the laundering of the proceeds of sale, of any prohibited narcotic substances
or the laundering of the proceeds gained from any other serious criminal activity,
whether that sale or laundering or other serious criminal activity occurred in Niue
or elsewhere.
(4) Nothing in this section shall prevent the Court from requiring any
person to produce documents or to give evidence in any proceedings of any facts
relevant in such proceedings in a court in Niue.
––––––––––––––––––––––
1358 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF ISSUE

1 Eligibility

(1) Bonds issued under this Act may be held by –

(a) An individual;

(b) Two or more persons as joint tenants;

(c) Any limited liability company;

(d) Any partnership, special partnership or limited liability partnership;

(e) Any trust or trustee; and

(f) Any other corporate entity.

(2) If at any time a Bondholder is not eligible to hold a Bond the Bank reserves

the right to repay any Bonds issued under this Act.

2 Niue Development Bonds

(1) The Bank may issue Bonds in multiples of NZ$500,000 or in such other

multiples as Cabinet may approve.

(2) The Bonds will be issued at par.

3 Applications

(1) Any person eligible to hold a Bond may make an application to the Bank in

the form specified in Schedule 2.

(2) The Minister may impose a limit upon the value of Bonds that a Bondholder

may hold.

(3) Applications lodged after 3pm at any receiving office of the Bank shall be

deemed to have been received on the first working day following the date of lodgement.

(4) Applications must be accompanied by the full issue price and must be received

prior to the designated Closing Date (“the Closing Date”).

(5) The Bank reserves the right to decline any application or applications and to

close any or all maturities of Bonds issued pursuant to this Act.

(6) All amounts received prior to the Closing Date will be banked into the

Government of Niue’s Consolidated Account for the Applicant’s account until the

application is accepted at which time they will be held on the Government of Niue’s

account.

(7) Upon acceptance by the Bank of an application the Bank shall issue a Bond

Certificate to the Bondholder in the form specified in Schedule 3.

(8) In the event the Issue is over-subscribed the Minister, whose decision shall in

all respects be final, will direct the Niue Bank to allocate the Bonds amongst applicants in

order of magnitude of subscription amount, after which any unallocated subscriptions

will be returned to the applicant, together with interest on it.

4 Registration

(1) The Bank shall keep a Register of all Bonds issued under this Act.

(2) The Register may be kept in book form, or in the form of a paper or card

record, or by computer or any device by means of which information is recorded or stored.

If the Register is kept by computer or any such device –

(a) The recording or storing of any information in it shall be deemed to be

the entry of it in the Register; and

(b) Any material subsequently derived from information so recorded or stored

shall be deemed to be an extract from the Register.

Niue Development Bonds Act 1994

1359

(3) The Bank shall cause to be entered in the Register the following particulars of every Bondholder –

(a) The name and address of the Bondholder;

(b) The amount of Bonds held by the Bondholder;

(c) The rate of interest payable in respect of the Bond;

(d) The date or dates on which the interest is payable;

(e) The due date of repayment of the Bond;

(f) Such other particulars as may be required by the Bank.

(4) Any extract from the Register, certified as correct by an officer of the Bank

purporting to act in the course of his duties as such shall, in the absence of evidence to the

contrary, for all purposes and in all courts, be sufficient evidence of the entry in the Register

to which the extract relates as on the date when the extract was so certified. Any such

certificate purporting to have been signed by such an officer shall, in the absence of proof

to the contrary, be deemed for all purposes to have been duly signed by such an officer.

(5) The Bank may, on such evidence as appears to it to be sufficient, correct errors

and remedy omissions in the Register or any entry in it or in Bond Certificates, and may

call in any outstanding bond certificate for that purpose.

(6) Where 2 or more persons are registered as the Bondholders of the same Bond

by virtue of any application, memorandum of transfer, or other instrument, then, unless

the contrary is expressed in the application, memorandum of transfer, or other instrument,

the persons shall be deemed to hold the stock as joint tenants with right of survivorship.

(7) On application by any Bondholder, the Bank shall issue to the applicant a

bond certificate certifying that the applicant is the registered Bondholder referred to therein

(being the whole or any part of the amount of the Bond of which the Bondholder is the

registered holder).

(8) Any bond certificate shall be conclusive evidence of the ownership of the

Bond to which it relates by the person named therein as the Bondholder. The Register

shall be maintained confidential by the Bank, such that only a registered Bondholder

may have access to the Register for the purposes of confirming its position as Bondholder.

(9) Subject to clause 7 the transfer, whether by delivery or otherwise, of any such

Bond Certificate shall not operate as a transfer of the legal or equitable interest of the

Bondholder to which it relates. The Bank shall not repay nor record any dealing with any

Bond for which a bond certificate has been issued, unless the bond certificate has been

produced to and cancelled by the Bank.

(10) The Bank shall enter in the Register particulars of the issue of every bond

certificate.

(11) Where any bond certificate has been lost, destroyed, mutilated or rendered

illegible, the Bank, on receiving evidence to its satisfaction of the loss or destruction or, as

the case may be, on the surrender of the mutilated or illegible bond certificate, may, on

such terms and subject to such conditions as the Bank prescribes, issue a substitute bond

certificate with the word “substitute” stamped or written on it, and shall record the issue

of it in the Register.

(12) Every such substitute bond certificate shall have the same effect to all intents

and purposes as the original bond certificate for which it is substituted.

5 Term

Bonds shall be issued for a term of one or more years from the date of

commencement and, if approved by Cabinet, may be subject to a right of renewal for a further period of one or more years.

1360 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

made 3 calendar months from the date of commencement and subsequent interest payments to be made at 3 calendar monthly intervals thereafter until maturity.

(4) Interest will be credited without apportionment to the Bondholder ’s nominated account at any registered bank or other financial institution in Niue or New Zealand or any other country.

7 Transferability

(1) Each Bond issued will be a negotiable transferable certificate of deposit. A

Bondholder may, by memorandum of transfer in the form specified in Schedule 4, transfer

the total amount of Bonds held or any part of it to another eligible party.

(2) On production of a duly executed memorandum of transfer, the Bank shall

enter in the Register the name of the transferee as the registered Bondholder of the Bond

to which the memorandum of transfer relates.

(3) Every such entry shall operate as a transfer of the Bonds to which it relates,

and shall vest those Bonds in the transferee.

(4) The Register will close for registration of transfers 10 days prior to each

quarterly interest date.

8 Bonds as security

Bonds may be mortgaged, charged, or pledged by the Bondholder.

9 Repayment

(1) Subject to clause 5(2), Bonds will be repaid on the date of repayment.

(2) At the date of repayment, Bondholders will receive the par value of the Bond

plus interest on it for 3 calendar month interval preceding the date of repayment.

(3) Repayment shall be made in the method specified for the payment of interest

in clause 6(4).

10 Special Terms

Bonds may be issued on such other additional terms as Cabinet may approve.

––––––––––––––––––––

Niue Development Bonds Act 1994

SCHEDULE 2

APPLICATION FORM

“Application for Niue Development Bonds”

1361

To

Niue Bank

[Address]

A

Investor Details

1

Surname

(or Company name):

First name(s)

2

Address

(or registered office including contact person)

3 Telephone numbers

Business:

Facsimile:

4 Niue Tax Number

(Note: This will be allocated automatically upon acceptance of the application if the

applicant does not hold a Niue tax number).

I/We/The Company hereby apply(ies) for Niue Development Bonds upon the terms and conditions set out in the Prospectus dated [Prospectus Date].

B Investment Details

1 No. of Bonds applied for:

2 Interest Rate: [Interest Rate]% (Interest rate effective from [Prospectus Date]).

Notes: Multiples of NZ$500,000 (or such other multiples as may be approved

by Cabinet).

Interest paid quarterly

Special terms of issue

C Payment Authority

1 Name of Bank Account:

2 Country:

3 Bank:

4 Bank Account No:

I/We/The Company hereby authorise(s) the Niue Bank to pay to the above bank account all interest and redemption proceeds which hereafter may become payable in respect of Niue Development Bonds for which the Niue Bank acts as Registrar and to accept their receipt as a full and final discharge, such order to remain in force until revoked by me/ us/the Company in writing.

Signature (signed on behalf of [The Company])

Date:

––––––––––––––––––––

1362 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

SCHEDULE 3

Form of Bond Certificate

Niue Bank

(being duly established under the Niue Bank Act 1994)

Certificate No.

“Certificate for Niue Development Bonds” Niue Bank

Treasury Department, Alofi, Niue

Niue Development Bonds (hereinafter called “Development Bonds”) constituted by this

Certificate are issued pursuant to the Niue Development Bonds Act 1994.

Name and Address of Bondholder: This is to certify that:

1 The Bondholder named in the above table is the registered holder of the principal

amount of registered Development Bonds of $500,000 [or such other multiples as

Cabinet may approve from time to time] principal amount which is set out in the table

below.

2 The Development Bonds comprised in this certificate bear interest at the interest rate

set out in the table below and are redeemable at par on the date of maturity set out in

the table below.

3 Interest on the development Bonds comprised in this certificate is payable on the Interest

Payment Dates set out in the table below and on the Date of Maturity.

NUMBER OF DEVELOPMENT BONDS: (in words and figures) INTEREST RATE:

INTEREST PAYMENT DATES:

DATE OF MATURITY:

COMMENCEMENT DATE:

SPECIAL TERMS:

CERTIFIED on behalf of the Niue Bank by:

The Minister of Finance for Niue

Director of Niue Bank (appointed pursuant

to section 23(2)(b) of the Niue Bank Act 1994)

NOTES

1 This certificate must be surrendered before any transfer of the whole or any number of

the Development Bonds comprised therein can be registered and no other than a

multiple of NZ$500,000 [or such other multiples as Cabinet may approve from time to

time] principal amount of Development Bonds may be transferred.

2 This certificate must be surrendered before redemption of the principal sum of the

Development Bonds comprised herein.

3 A copy of the terms and conditions of issue can be requested from the Niue Bank at

any time.

––––––––––––––––––––

Niue Development Bonds Act 1994

SCHEDULE 4

Memorandum of Transfer

Niue Bank

1363

“Memorandum of Transfer of Niue Development Bonds”(For use in respect of the transfer of registered Niue Development Bonds)

PART 1

Particulars

Number of Development Bonds (in words and figures) Certificate No.

Interest Rate:

Date of Maturity:

Particulars of Registered Holder(s):

Surname(s)

(First name(s))

Address

(or Company Name)

(or Registered Office)

I/We/The Company hereby transfer(s) the Development Bonds described above to the person/s/ company named below.

Signatures of Registered Holder(s) (or on behalf of Company): PART 2

Particulars of Transferee(s) of Development Bonds

Consideration

Transferee(s)

Surname(s) (First name(s)) Address

(or Company Name) (or Registered Office)

Tax No (if exempt from withholding tax please attach exemption certificates):

I/We/The Company confirm(s) that the Development Bond(s) described above has (have)

been acquired on the terms and conditions pursuant to the Niue Development Bonds Act

1994 and I/We/the Company request(s) that such entries be made in the register as are

necessary to give effect to this transfer.

PAYMENT AUTHORITY

I/We/The Company hereby authorise the Niue Bank to pay to the bank account below all interest and redemption proceeds which hereafter may become payable in respect of Niue Bonds of which the Niue Bank acts as Registrar and to accept their receipt as a full and sufficient discharge, such order to remain in force until revoked by me/us/the Company in writing.

1364 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Name of Bank Account: Country:

Bank:

Bank Account No:

Signatures of Transferee(s) (or on behalf of the Company); Date:

1365

NIUE FLAG ACT 1975

1975/16 – 1975

1

Short title

4

Offences

2

Niue Flag

3

Regulations

SCHEDULE

To provide for the establishment and use of a Niue Flag

1 Short title

This is the Niue Flag Act 1975.

2 Niue Flag

(1) The Niue Flag shall be the flag described in the Schedule.
(2) The Niue Flag is hereby declared to be the recognised flag of Niue.
(3) Any other flag hitherto prescribed or used as the recognised flag of
Niue is hereby declared to be disestablished in Niue.

3 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations prescribing the circumstances in which and
the conditions subject to which the Niue Flag may be flown.

4 Offences

Every person who defaces the Niue Flag by placing any sign, representation,
or letter thereon commits an offence, and is liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty
units or a term of imprisonment not exceeding 6 months.
–––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE THE NIUE FLAG

The Niue Flag shall be described as follows:

“The Niue National Flag shall be a golden yellow flag, bearing on the upper canton

of the hoist thereof the Union Flag, commonly known as the Union Jack,

displaying 2 five-pointed yellow stars on the vertical line and on the horizontal

line thereof separated by a blue disc containing a larger five-pointed yellow

star.”

AND IT SHALL MEAN:

Golden yellow represents the bright sunshine of Niue and the warm feelings of

the Niuean people towards New Zealand and her people.

1366 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

The Union Flag, commonly known as the Union Jack represents that Niue was a British Protectorate, proclaimed on 19 October 1900 after petitioning by the Kings and Chiefs of Niue to Great Britain for the Union Flag to be flown in Niue as the symbol of protection.

The four small stars represent the Southern Cross and New Zealand under whose administration Niue was placed by Great Britain in 1901 and as well reflecting the continuing close relationship between Niue and New Zealand.

The larger star within the blue disc represents the self-governing status of Niue, standing alone within the deep blue sea.

1367

NIUE PHILATELIC AND NUMISMATIC ACT 1996

1996/206 – 16 May 1996

1

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

Short title

15

PART 3

PERSONNEL

Company employees

2

Interpretation

16

Application of the Niue Public Service

3

Application

terms and conditions

4

General objectives of the Act

PART 4

PART 2

FINANCIAL PROVISIONS

THE NIUE PHILATELIC AND NUMISMATIC COMPANY 17 Annual estimates

5

The Company established

18

Accounts and records

6

Functions and powers of the Company

19

[Repealed]

7

Government policy

20

Annual report

8

Board of Directors

21

Taxation

9

Chairperson

22

Dividends

10

Disclosure of interest

11

Directors not personally liable

PART 5

12

Contracts by the Company

MISCELLANEOUS

13

Committees

23

Regulations

14

Delegation of powers

To establish the Niue Philatelic and Numismatic Company for the purpose of conducting Philatelic and Numismatic business

1 Short title

This is the Philatelic and Numismatic Act 1996.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Board” means the Board of Directors appointed under this Act;
“Company” means the Niue Philatelic and Numismatic Company;
“Minister” means the Minister of Finance;
“numismatic” means matters dealing with or concerning coins or coinage.
“other revenue earning options” means options approved by Cabinet, that
may earn Niue revenue;
“philatelic” means matters dealing with or concerning stamps;
“regulations” means regulations made under section 23;
“services” in addition to philatelic and numismatic, includes any other
service carried out by the Company under this Act.
1368 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

3 Application

This Act shall bind the Crown except as specified in this Act or the
regulations but nothing in this Act shall render the Crown liable to any prosecution.

4 General objectives of the Act

The general objectives of the Act are to provide for philatelic and numismatic
and other matters to be controlled by a company subject to this Act.
PART 2
THE NIUE PHILATELIC AND NUMISMATIC COMPANY

5 The Company established

There is hereby established a Company to be called the Niue Philatelic and
Numismatic Company.

6 Functions and powers of the Company

The functions of the Company shall be to adminster philatelic, numismatic
and other revenue earning options and services.

7 Government policy

In the exercise of its functions and powers under this Act the Company
shall have regard to the general policy of the Government in relation to philatelic,
numismatic and any other revenue earning options of the Government and shall
comply with any directions given by Cabinet under any such policy.

8 Board of Directors

(1) The Company shall be governed by a Board of Directors consisting of
the following directors –
(a) The Minister of Finance;
(b) The Government Solicitor;
(c) The Financial Secretary.
(2) Without limiting the generality of the powers and functions of the
Company as provided under this Act, the Board shall –
(a) Ensure that the functions of the Company are performed efficiently;
(b) Maintain the independence and integrity of the Company;
(c) Ensure the assets of the Company are as far as practicable preserved,
maintained and utilised in a way consistent with the functions of
the Company;
(d) Ensure that the Company does not contravene or fail to comply
with any of the provisions of this Act or any directions given under
section 7.

9 Chairperson

Cabinet shall appoint one of the directors to act as Chairperson.

10 Disclosure of interest

A director who has a direct or indirect pecuniary interest in a matter being
considered or about to be considered by the Board shall, as soon as possible after
the relevant facts have come to his knowledge, disclose the nature of his interest
at a meeting of the Board.

Niue Philatelic and Numismatic Act 1996

1369

11 Directors not personally liable

No director of the Company shall be personally liable for any act done or
default made by the Company or by any of its employees in good faith in the
course of operations of the Company.

12 Contracts by the Company

The Company may enter into contracts.

13 Committees

(1) The Company may appoint committees consisting of any directors of
officers of the Company.
(2) Subject to the other provisions of this Act and to directions given to it
by the Company, every committee may regulate its procedure in such a manner
as it thinks fit.

14 Delegation of powers

(1) The Company may delegate in writing to any of its committees or to
the Manager, or to any other officer of the Company any of its powers under this
Act, including this present power of delegation.
(2) Subject to any general or special directions given to it or to him by the
Company any committee or person to whom any powers are so delegated may
exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same effect as if they had
been conferred on it directly by this Act and not by delegation.
(3) Any committee or person purporting to act under any delegation under
this section shall be presumed, until the contrary is proven, to be acting under the
terms of the delegation.
(4) Every such delegation shall be revocable in writing at will, and no such
delegation shall prevent the exercise of any power by the Company itself.
(5) Until any such delegation is revoked it shall continue in force in
accordance with its tenor, notwithstanding any change in the membership of the
Company or any committee.

15 Company employees

PART 3
PERSONNEL
(1) The Company may employ such officers and employees as it considers necessary for the performance of its functions, on such terms and conditions as provided under section 17 and may at any time remove any such officer or employee from his office or employment.
(2) For the purpose of article 62 (3) of the Constitution employees of the Company shall not be regarded as members of the Niue Public Service for the purpose of their duties with the Company.

16 Application of the Niue Public Service terms and conditions

The Company may with any necessary modifications, apply the terms and
conditions applicable to the Niue Public Service.
1370 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

17 Annual estimates

PART 4
FINANCIAL PROVISIONS
(1) The Company shall, for each financial year prepare an estimate, in a form approved by the Minister of the amount of expenditure and revenue for all purposes and the receipts of the Company. The annual balance date of the Company shall be 30 June.
(2) The estimates so prepared shall be submitted to the Assembly not later than such date as the Minister directs, for the approval of such estimates by the Assembly, and the funds of the Company shall not be expended otherwise than in accordance with estimates of expenditure so approved.

18 Accounts and records

The Company shall keep proper accounts and records of the transactions
and affairs of the Company and shall do all things necessary to ensure that all
payments out of its funds are correctly made and properly authorised and that
adequate control is maintained over the assets of or in the custody of the Company
and over incurring of liabilities by the Company.

19 [Repealed by 2003/262]

20 Annual report

The Company shall within 3 months after the end of the Company’s
financial year prepare and furnish to Cabinet and the Assembly a report on its
operation during the year ended on that date together with financial statements
in respect of that year in such form as the Minister approves.

21 Taxation

The Company shall be subject to taxation.

22 Dividends

The Company shall pay a dividend to the Government as agreed by the
Board.

23 Regulations

PART 5
MISCELLANEOUS
Cabinet may on the recommendation of the Company make regulations necessary for carrying out or giving full effect to this Act.
1371

NIUE TRUST FUND ACT 2004

2004/226 – 19 May 2004

1

Short title

6

Provision of information

2

Interpretation

7

Information for the Assembly

3

Status of Fund

8

Taxation exemption

4

Government contributions

9

Secretarial support

5

Application of money received by

10

Regulations

Government

To implement in Niue the Agreement concerning a Trust Fund for Niue and to make financial provision for the Fund

1 Short title

This is the Niue Trust Fund Act 2004.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Advisory Committee” means the Advisory Committee for the Fund;
“Agreement” means the international treaty to be concluded, entitled the
Agreement concerning a Trust Fund for Niue, to which Niue will be a
party;
“Auditor” means the Auditor appointed by the Board under article 22 of
the Agreement
“Board” means the Board of Directors of the Fund;
“Fund” means the Niue Trust Fund to be set up by the Agreement;
“Minister” means the Minister for Finance;
“public money” has the same meaning as in the Public Revenues Act 1959.

3 Status of Fund

(1) The Fund is a body corporate with all the rights and powers of a natural
person of full age and capacity, to be exercised for the purposes of the Fund.
(2) The Fund is not a public fund of Niue and the capital and revenue
(except money referred to in section 5) of the Fund is not public money of Niue
nor subject in Niue law to control and accounting except as provided by this Act.

4 Government contributions

(1) The Government may at any time contribute to the Fund –
(a) Such moneys as may be appropriated for the purpose by the
Assembly; and
(b) Money or securities received by the Government from any other
source.
1372 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) The Government may without further procedure make an initial contribution of $50,000 to the Fund.
(3) Contributions under this section may be made only as direct cash payments, donations, or interest free loans.

5 Application of money received by Government

Money received by the Government from the Fund –
(a) Shall become public money and shall be paid only into the Niue
Government Account until article 57 of the Constitution;
(b) Shall be spent only under Part 4 of the Constitution; and
(c) Shall be accounted for under Part 4 of the Constitution.

6 Provision of information

The Government and any public officer or other person may, and shall on
request, give to the Board, the Advisory Committee or any other person authorised
by them or on their behalf –
(a) Any information or documents which the Auditor requires to fulfil
its obligations under article 22 of the Agreement;
(b) Any information or documents relating to the national budget,
annual estimates or appropriation for the service of the financial
year before or after the national budget has been presented to the
Assembly;
(c) The annual accounts of Niue furnished under section 25 of the Public
Revenues Act 1959; and
(d) The audit report prepared under article 60 of the Constitution.

7 Information for the Assembly

The following documents shall be laid before the Assembly at its sitting
next following the date on which the document is received by Government –
(a) The annual report by the Board;
(b) The annual accounts of the Fund;
(c) The report by the Auditor of the Fund on its annual accounts; and
(d) The annual report, and the first 6 monthly report, of the Advisory
Committee.

8 Taxation exemption

Contributions to and income received by the Fund shall be exempt from
payment of all taxes, rates and duties in the hands of the Fund.

9 Secretarial support

The Government shall provide the administrative, secretarial and other
services necessary for the purposes of the Fund.

10 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations for the purposes of this Act.
1373

OCCUPIERS’ LIABILITY ACT 1962

1962/31 (NZ) – 1 January 1963

1

Short title

7

Occupier ’s duty to contractual visitors

2

Interpretation

8

Landlord’s liability in virtue of obligation

3

Application of sections 4 and 5

to repair

4

Extent of occupier ’s ordinary duty

9

Act not to apply to certain contracts of hire

5

Effect of contract on occupier ’s liability to

or carriage

third party

10

Act to bind the Crown

6

Contribution between landlord and tenant

as joint tortfeasors

To amend the law relating to the liability of occupiers and others for injury or damage resulting to persons or goods lawfully on any land or other property from dangers due to the state of the property or to things done or omitted to be done there

1 Short title

This is the Occupiers’ Liability Act 1962.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“premises” includes land;
“structure” includes any vessel, vehicle, or aircraft.

3 Application of sections 4 and 5

(1) The rules enacted by sections 4 and 5 shall have effect, in place of the
rules of the common law, to regulate the duty which an occupier of premises owes
to his visitors in his capacity as an occupier in respect of dangers due to the state
of the premises or to things done or omitted to be done on them.
(2) The rules so enacted shall regulate the nature of the duty imposed by
law in consequence of a person’s occupation or control of premises and of any
invitation or permission he gives, or is to be treated as giving, to another to enter
or use the premises, but they shall not alter the rules of the common law as to the
persons on whom a duty is so imposed or to whom it is owed; and accordingly for
the purpose of the rules so enacted the persons who are to be treated as an occupier
and as his visitors are the same as the persons who would at common law be
treated as an occupier and as his invitees or licensees.
(3) Subject to section 9, the rules so enacted in relation to an occupier of
premises and his visitors shall also apply, in like manner and to the like extent as
the principles applicable at common law and to an occupier of premises and his
invitees or licensees would apply, to regulate –
1374 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) The obligations of a person occupying or having control over any fixed or movable structure; and
(b) The obligations of a person occupying or having control over any premises or structure in respect of damage to property, including the property of persons who are not themselves his visitors.

4 Extent of occupier’s ordinary duty

(1) An occupier of premises owes the same duty (in this Act referred to as
the common duty of care) to all his visitors, except so far as he is free to and does
extend, restrict, modify, or exclude his duty to any visitor or visitors by agreement
or otherwise.
(2) The common duty of care is a duty to take such care as in all the
circumstances of the case is reasonable to see that the visitor will be reasonably
safe in using the premises for the purposes for which he is invited or permitted by
the occupier to be there.
(3) The circumstances relevant for the present purpose include the degree
of care, and of want of care, which would ordinarily be looked for in such a visitor.
(4) In determining whether the occupier of premises has discharged the
common duty of care to a visitor, regard is to be had to all the circumstances.
(5) Where damage is caused to a visitor by a danger of which he had been
warned by the occupier, the warning is not to be treated without more as absolving
the occupier from liability, unless in all the circumstances it was enough to enable
the visitor to be reasonably safe.
(6) Where damage is caused to a visitor by a danger due to the faulty
execution of any work of construction, reconstruction, demolition, maintenance,
repair, or other like operation by an independent contractor employed by the
occupier, the occupier is not to be treated without more as answerable for the
danger if in all the circumstances he had acted reasonably in entrusting the work
to an independent contractor and had taken such steps (if any) as he reasonably
ought in order to satisfy himself that the contractor was competent and that the
work had been properly done.
(7) The common duty of care does not impose on an occupier any obligation
to a visitor in respect of risks willingly accepted as his by the visitor.
(8) Where the occupier fails or neglects to discharge the common duty of
care to a visitor, and the visitor suffers damage as the result partly of that fault
and partly of his own fault section 736 of the Niue Act 1966 shall apply.
(9) For the purposes of this section, persons who enter premises for any
purpose in the exercise of a right conferred by law are to be treated as permitted
by the occupier to be there for that purpose, whether they in fact have his
permission or not.

5 Effect of contract on occupier’s liability to third party

(1) Where an occupier of premises is bound by contract to permit persons
who are strangers to the contract to enter or use the premises, the common duty
of care which he owes to them as his visitors cannot be restricted or excluded by
that contract, but (subject to any provision of the contract to the contrary) shall
include the duty to perform his obligations under the contract, whether undertaken
for their protection or not, so far as those obligations go beyond the obligations
otherwise involved in the common duty of care.
(2) A contract shall not by virtue of this section have the effect, unless it
expressly so provides, of making an occupier who has taken all reasonable care
answerable to strangers to the contract for dangers due to the faulty execution of

Occupiers’ Liability Act 1962

1375
any work of construction, reconstruction, demolition, maintenance, repair, or other like operation by persons other than himself, his servants, and persons acting under his direction and control.
(3) In this section “stranger to the contract” means a person not for the time being entitled to the benefit of the contract as a party to it or as the successor by assignment or otherwise of a party to it, and accordingly includes a party to the contract who has ceased to be so entitled.
(4) Where by the terms or conditions governing any tenancy (including a statutory tenancy which does not in law amount to a tenancy) either the landlord or the tenant is bound, though not by contract, to permit persons to enter or use premises of which he is the occupier, this section shall apply as if the tenancy were a contract between the landlord and the tenant.

6 Contribution between landlord and tenant as joint tortfeasors

(1) Where a landlord is the occupier of any part of any premises that is
used by a tenant, and damage is suffered by a visitor to that part of the premises
as a result of the fault of the landlord and of the tenant, and the tenant would, if
sued, have been liable to the visitor in respect of the damage, the landlord shall
have the same right to recover contribution from the tenant as if the tenant were a
joint occupier of that part of the premises.
(2) Where a tenant is the occupier of any part of any premises, and damage
is suffered by a visitor to that part of the premises as a result of the fault of the
tenant and of the landlord, and the landlord would, if sued, have been liable to
the visitor in respect of the damage, the tenant shall have the same right to recover
contribution from the landlord as if the landlord were a joint occupier of that part
of the premises.
(3) For the purposes of this section –
“landlord” includes both an immediate and a superior landlord;
“tenant” includes a person occupying premises under a statutory tenancy
which does not in law amount to a tenancy, or under any contract
conferring a right of occupation; and also includes a subtenant.

7 Occupier’s duty to contractual visitors

(1) Where persons enter or use, or bring or send goods to, any premises in
exercise of a right conferred on them b contract with a person occupying or having
control of the premises, the duty he owes them, in his capacity as occupier, in
respect of dangers due to the state of the premises or to things done or omitted to
be done on them shall be the common duty of care, except so far as a contrary
intention is expressed in the contract; and section 4 (2) to (8) shall apply accordingly.
(2) In determining whether in any such case the occupier has discharged
the common duty of care, so far as it is applicable, the existence and nature of the
contract shall be included in the circumstances to which regard is to be had under
section 4.
(3) Subject to section 9, this section shall apply to fixed and movable
structures as it applies to premises.

8 Landlord’s liability in virtue of obligation to repair

(1) Where premises are occupied by any person under a tenancy which
puts on the landlord an obligation to that person for the maintenance or repair of
the premises, the landlord shall owe to all persons who or whose goods may from
time to time be lawfully on the premises the same duty, in respect of dangers
arising from any default by him in carrying out that obligation, as if he were an
1376 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
occupier of the premises and those persons or their goods were there by his invitation or permission but without any contract.
(2) Where premises are occupied under a subtenancy, subsection (1) shall apply to any landlord of the premises (whether the immediate or a superior landlord) on whom an obligation to the occupier for the maintenance or repair of the premises is put by the subtenancy, and for that purpose any obligation to the occupier which the subtenancy puts on a mesne landlord of the premises, or is treated by virtue of this provision as putting on a mesne landlord, shall be treated as put by it also on any landlord on whom the mesne landlord’s tenancy puts the like obligation towards the mesne landlord.
(3) For the purposes of this section, where premises comprised in a tenancy (whether occupied under that tenancy or under a subtenancy) are put to a use not permitted by the tenancy, and the landlord of whom they are held under the tenancy is not debarred by his acquiescence or otherwise from objecting or from enforcing his objection, then no persons or goods whose presence on the premises is due solely to that use of the premises shall be deemed to be lawfully on the premises as regards that landlord or any superior landlord of the premises, whether or not they are lawfully there as regards an inferior landlord.
(4) For the purposes of this section, a landlord shall not be deemed to have made default in carrying out any obligation to the occupier of the premises unless his default is such as to be actionable at the suit of the occupier or, in the case of a superior landlord whose actual obligation is to an inferior landlord, his default in carrying out that obligation is actionable at the suit of the inferior landlord.
(5) This section shall not put a landlord of premises under a greater duty
than the occupier to persons who or whose goods are lawfully on the premises by
reason only of the exercise of a right of way.
(6) Nothing in this section shall relieve a landlord of any duty which he is
under apart from this section.
(7) For the purposes of this section, obligations imposed by any enactment
in virtue of a tenancy shall be treated as imposed by the tenancy; and “tenancy”
includes a statutory tenancy which does not in law amount to a tenancy, and
includes also any contract conferring a right of occupation; and “landlord” shall
be construed accordingly.

9 Act not to apply to certain contracts of hire or carriage

This Act shall not apply to the obligations of any person under or by virtue
of any contract for the hire of, or for the carriage for reward of persons or goods
in, any vehicle, vessel, aircraft, or other means of transport, or under or by virtue
of any contract of bailment.

10 Act to bind the Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.
1377

PARTNERSHIP ACT 1908

1908/138 (NZ) – 4 August 1908

26 Procedure against partnership property for partner ’s separate debt

27 Rules as to interests and duties of partners

28 Expulsion of partner

29 Retirement from partnership at will

30 Conditions of partnership where term

continued over

31 Duty to render accounts

32 Partners to account for private profits

33 Partner not to compete with firm

34 Rights of assignee of share in partnership

Relations of Partners to Persons Dealing With

Them

8 Power of partner to bind the firm

9 Partners bound by Acts on behalf of firm

10 Partner using credit of firm for private

purposes

11 Effect of notice that firm will not be bound

by acts of partner

12 Liability of partners

13 Liability of the firm for wrongs

14 Misapplication of money received for firm

15 Joint and several liability

16 Improper employment of trust property for

partnership purposes

17 Persons liable by “holding out”

18 Admissions and representations of partners

19 Notice to acting partner to be notice to firm

20 Liabilities of incoming and outgoing

partners

21 Revocation of continuing guaranty by

change in firm

Relations of Partners to One Another

22 Variation by consent of terms of

partnership

23 Partnership property

24 Property bought with partnership money

25 Conversion into personal estate of land

Dissolution of Partnership and its Consequences

35 Dissolution by expiration or notice

36 Dissolution by death, bankruptcy, or charge

37 Dissolution by illegality of partnership

38 Dissolution by the Court

39 Rights of persons dealing with firm against

apparent members

40 Right of partners to notify dissolution

41 Continuing authority of partners for

purposes of winding up

42 Rights of partners as to application of

partnership property

43 Apportionment of premium where

partnership prematurely dissolved

44 Rights where partnership dissolved for

fraud or misrepresentation

45 Right of outgoing partner to share profits

made after dissolution

46 Retiring or deceased partner ’s share to be

debt

47 Distribution of assets on final settlement of

accounts

PART 2

SPECIAL PARTNERSHIPS

48 Part 1 not to affect special partnerships

49 Special partnerships may be formed, except

for banking and insurance

50 General and special partners, and their

liabilities

51 Certificates to be signed by partners

held as partnership property 52 Style of partnership

1378

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

53

When special partner deemed general

partner

54

Certificates to be acknowledged and

registered

55

False statement in certificate: partners liable

as general partners

56

Copy of certificate to be published

57

Duration of partnerships

58

Certificate to be signed on renewal

59

Capital stock not to be withdrawn

60

When special partners liable to refund

capital withdrawn

To consolidate certain enactments relating to partnership

1 Short title

This is the Partnership Act 1908.

2 Interpretation

In this Act, “business” includes every trade, occupation, or profession.

3 Saving for rules of equity and common law

The rules of equity and of common law applicable to partnership shall
continue in force except so far as they are inconsistent with this Act.
PART 1
THE GENERAL LAW RELATING TO PARTNERS

Nature of Partnership

4 Definition of partnership

(1) Partnership is the relation which subsists between persons carrying on
a business in common with a view to profit.
(2) The relationship between members of a company or association
registered under the Companies Act 2006 is not a partnership within the meaning
of this Act.

5 Rules for determining existence of partnership

In determining whether a partnership does or does not exist regard shall
be had to the following rules:
(a) Joint tenancy, tenancy in common, joint property, or part ownership
does not of itself create a partnership as to anything so held or
owned, whether the tenants or owners do or do not share any profits
made by the use of it;
(b) The sharing of gross returns does not of itself create a partnership,
whether the persons sharing such returns have or have not a joint
or common right or interest in any property from which or from
the use of which the returns are derived;
(c) The receipt by a person of a share of the profits of a business is
prima facie evidence that he is a partner in the business, but the
receipt of such a share or of a payment contingent on or varying
with the profits of a business does not of itself make him a partner
in the business and, in particular –

Partnership Act 1908

1379
(i) the receipt by a person of a debt or other liquidated amount, by instalments or otherwise, out of the accruing profits of a business does not of itself make him a partner in the business or liable as such;
(ii) a contract for the remuneration of a servant or agent of a person engaged in a business by a share of the profits of the business does not of itself make the servant or agent a partner in the business or liable as such;
(iii) a person being the widow or child of a deceased partner, and
receiving by way of annuity a portion of the profits made in
the business in which the deceased person was a partner, is not
by reason only of such receipt a partner in the business or liable
as such;
(iv) the advance of money by way of loan to a person engaged or
about to engage in any business on a contract with that person
that the lender shall receive a rate of interest varying with the
profits, or shall receive a share of the profits arising from
carrying on the business, does not of itself make the lender a
partner with the person or persons carrying on the business,
or liable as such:
Provided that the contract is in writing, and signed by or on
behalf of all the parties to it;
(v) a person receiving by way of annuity or otherwise a portion of
the profits of a business in consideration of the sale by him of
the goodwill of the business is not, by reason only of such
receipt, a partner in the business or liable as such.

6 Rights of person lending or selling in consideration of share of profits in case of bankruptcy

In the event of any person to whom money has been advanced by way of loan upon such a contract as is mentioned in section 5, or of any buyer of a goodwill in consideration of a share of the profits of the business, being adjudged a bankrupt, entering into an arrangement to pay his creditors less than 100 cents in the dollar, or dying in insolvent circumstances the lender of the loan shall not be entitled to recover anything in respect of his loan, and the seller of the goodwill shall not be entitled to recover anything in respect of the share of profits contracted for, until the claims of the other creditors of the borrower or buyer for valuable consideration in money or money’s worth have been satisfied.

7 Meaning of “firm”

Persons who have entered into partnership with one another are for the
purposes of this Act called collectively a “firm”, and the name under which their
business is carried on is called the “firm name”.

Relations of Partners to Persons Dealing with Them

8 Power of partner to bind the firm

Every partner is an agent of the firm and his other partners, for the purpose
of the business of the partnership; and the acts of every partner who does any act
for carrying on in the usual way business of the kind carried on by the firm of
which he is a member bind the firm and his partners, unless the partner so acting
has in fact no authority to act for the firm in the particular matter, and the person
with whom he is dealing either knows that he has no authority or does not know
or believe him to be a partner.
1380 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

9 Partners bound by acts on behalf of firm

(1) An act or instrument relating to the business of the firm and done or
executed in the firm name, or in any other manner showing an intention to bind
the firm, by any person authorised for the purpose whether a partner or not, is
binding on the firm and all the partners.
(2) This section shall not affect any general rule of law relating to the
execution of deeds or negotiable instruments.

10 Partner using credit of firm for private purposes

(1) Where one partner pledges the credit of the firm for a purpose
apparently not connected with the firm’s ordinary course of business, the firm is
not bound unless he is in fact specially authorised by the other partners.
(2) This section does not affect any personal liability incurred by an
individual partner.

11 Effect of notice that firm will not be bound by acts of partner

If it has been agreed between the partners that any restriction shall be placed
on the power of any one or more of them to bind the firm, no act done in
contravention of the agreement is binding on the firm with respect to persons
having notice of the agreement.

12 Liability of partners

Every partner in a firm is liable jointly with the other partners for all debts
and obligations of the firm incurred while he is a partner; and after his death his
estate is also severally liable in a due course of administration for such debts and
obligations as far as they remain unsatisfied, but subject to the prior payment of
his separate debts.

13 Liability of the firm for wrongs

Where by the wrongful act or omission of any partner acting in the ordinary
course of the business of the firm, or with the authority of his co-partners, loss or
injury is caused to any person not being a partner in the firm, or any penalty is
incurred, the firm is liable therefor to the same extent as the partner so acting or
omitting to act.

14 Misapplication of money received for firm

The firm is liable to make good the loss –
(a) Where one partner acting within the scope of his apparent authority
receives the money or property of a third person and misapplies it;
and
(b) Where a firm in the course of its business receives money or property
of a third person, and the money or property so received is
misapplied by one or more of the partners while it is in the custody
of the firm.

15 Joint and several liability

Every partner is liable jointly with his co-partners and also severally for
everything for which the firm, while he is a partner in it, becomes liable under
sections 13 and 14.

Partnership Act 1908

1381

16 Improper employment of trust property for partnership purposes

(1) If a partner, being a trustee, improperly employs trust property in the
business or on the account of the partnership, no other partner is liable for the
trust property to the persons beneficially interested in it.
(2) (a) This section shall not affect any liability incurred by any partner by
reason of his having notice of a breach of trust.
(b) Nothing in this section shall prevent trust money from being
followed and recovered from the firm if still in its possession or
under its control.

17 Persons liable by “holding out”

(1) Every one who, by words spoken or written, or by conduct, represents
himself, or who knowingly suffers himself to be represented, as a partner in a
particular firm is liable as a partner to any one who has, on the faith of any such
representation, given credit to the firm, whether the representation has or has not
been made or communicated to the person so giving credit by or with the
knowledge of the apparent partner making the representation or suffering it to be
made.
(2) Where after a partner ’s death the partnership business is continued in the old firm’s name, the continued use of that name or of the deceased partner ’s name as part of it shall not of itself make his executors or administrators estate or effects liable for any partnership debts contracted after his death.

18 Admissions and representations of partners

An admission or representation made by any partner concerning the
partnership affairs, and in the ordinary course of its business, is evidence against
the firm.

19 Notice to acting partner to be notice to firm

Notice to any partner who habitually acts in the partnership business of
any matter relating to partnership affairs operates as notice to the firm, except in
the case of a fraud on the firm committed by or with the consent of that partner.

20 Liabilities of incoming and outgoing partners

(1) A person who is admitted as a partner into an existing firm does not
thereby become liable to the creditors of the firm for anything done before he
became a partner.
(2) A partner who retires from a firm does not thereby cease to be liable for
partnership debts or obligations incurred before his retirement.
(3) A retiring partner may be discharged from any existing liabilities by an
agreement to that effect between himself and the members of the firm as newly
constituted and the creditors, and this agreement may be either express or inferred
as a fact from the course of dealing between the creditors and the firm as newly
constituted.

21 Revocation of continuing guaranty by change in firm

A continuing guaranty given either to a firm or to a third person in respect
of the transactions of a firm is, in the absence of agreement to the contrary, revoked
as to future transactions by any change in the constitution of the firm to which, or
of the firm in respect of the transactions of which, the guaranty was given.
1382 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Relations of Partners to One Another

22 Variation by consent of terms of partnership

The mutual rights and duties of partners, whether ascertained by agreement
or defined by this Act, may be varied by the consent of all the partners, and such
consent may be either express or inferred from a course of dealing.

23 Partnership property

(1) All property and rights and interests in property originally brought
into the partnership stock, or acquired (whether by purchase or otherwise) on
account of the firm or for the purposes and in the course of the partnership business,
are called in this Act “partnership property” and must be held and applied by the
partners exclusively for the purposes of the partnership and under the partnership
agreement.
(2) The legal estate or interest in any land which belongs to the partnership
shall devolve under the nature and tenure thereof and the general rules of law
thereto applicable, but in trust, so far as necessary, for the persons beneficially
interested in the land under this section.
(3) Where co-owners of an estate or interest in any land not being itself
partnership property are partner as to profits made by the use of that land or
estate, ad purchase other land or estate out of the profits to be used in like manner,
the land or estate so purchased belongs to them, in the absence of an agreement to
the contrary, not as partners, but as co-owners for the same respective estates and
interests as are held by them in the land or estate first mentioned at the date of the
purchase.

24 Property bought with partnership money

Unless the contrary intention appears, property bought with money
belonging to the firm is deemed to have been bought on account of the firm.

25 Conversion into personal estate of land held as partnership property

Where land has become partnership property it shall, unless the contrary
intention appears, be treated as between the partners (including the representatives
of a deceased partner), and also as between the heirs of a deceased partner and his
executors or administrators, as personal and not real estate.

26 Procedure against partnership property for partner’s separate debt

(1) A writ of execution shall not issue against any partnership property
except on a judgement against the firm.
(2) The Court or a Judge may on the application by summons of any
judgment creditor of a partner, make an order charging that partner ’s interest in
the partnership property and profits with payment of the amount of the judgment
debt and interest on it, and may by the same or a subsequent order appoint a
receiver of that partner ’s share of profits (whether already declared or accruing),
and of any other money coming to him in respect of the partnership, and direct all
accounts and inquiries and give all other orders and directions which might have
been directed or given if the charge had been made in favour of the judgment
creditor by the partner, or which the circumstances of the case require.
(3) The other partner or partners shall be at liberty at any time to redeem
the interest charged or, in case of a sale being directed, to purchase the same.

Partnership Act 1908

1383

27 Rules as to interests and duties of partners

The interests of partners in the partnership property, and their rights and
duties in relation to the partnership, shall be determined, subject to any agreement
(express or implied) between the partners, by the following rules:
(a) All the partners are entitled to share equally in the capital and profits
of the business, and must contribute equally towards the losses,
whether of capital or otherwise, sustained by the firm.
(b) The firm must indemnify every partner in respect of payments made
and personal liabilities incurred by him –
(i) in the ordinary and proper conduct of the business of the firm;
or
(ii) in or about anything necessarily done for the preservation of
the business or property of the firm.
(c) A partner making, for the purpose of the partnership, any actual
payment or advance beyond the amount of capital which he has
agreed to subscribe is entitled to interest at the rate of 5% per annum
from the date of the payment or advance.
(d) A partner is not entitled, before the ascertainment of profits, to
interest on the capital subscribed by him.
(e) Every partner may take part in the management of the partnership
business.
(f) No partner shall be entitled to remuneration for acting in the
partnership business.
(g) No person may be introduced as a partner without the consent of
all existing partners.
(h) Any difference arising as to ordinary matters connected with the
partnership business may be decided by a majority of the partners,
but no change may be made in the nature of the partnership business
without the consent of all existing partners.
(i) The partnership books are to be kept at the place of business of the
partnership (or the principal place if there is more than one), and
every partner may have access to and inspect and copy any of them.

28 Expulsion of partner

A majority of the partners cannot expel any partner unless a power to do
so has been conferred by express agreement between the partners.

29 Retirement from partnership at will

(1) Where no fixed term has been agreed upon for the duration of the
partnership, any partner may determine the partnership at any time on giving
notice of his intention so to do to all the other partners.
(2) Where the partnership has originally been constituted by deed, a notice
in writing, signed by the partner giving it, shall be sufficient for this purpose.

30 Conditions of partnership where term continued over

(1) Where a partnership entered into for a fixed term is continued after the
term has expired, and without any expressed new agreement, the rights and duties
of the partners remain the same as they were at the expiration of the term, so far
as is consistent with the incidents of a partnership at will.
(2) A continuance of the business by the partners, or such of them as
habitually acted therein during the term, without any settlement or liquidation of
the partnership affairs is presumed to be a continuance of the partnership.
1384 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

31 Duty to render accounts

Partners are bound to render true accounts and full information of all things
affecting the partnership to any partner or his legal representatives.

32 Partners to account for private profits

(1) Every partner must account to the firm for any benefit derived by him
without the consent of the other partners from any transaction concerning the
partnership, or from any use by him of the partnership property, name, or business
connection.
(2) This section applies also to transactions undertaken after a partnership
has been dissolved by the death of a partner, and before the affairs thereof have
bee completely wound up, either by any surviving partner or by the representatives
of the deceased partner.

33 Partner not to compete with firm

If a partner, without the consent of the other partners, carries on any business
of the same nature as and competing with that of the firm, he must account for
and pay over to the firm all profits made by him in that business.

34 Rights of assignee of share in partnership

(1) An assignment by any partner of his share in the partnership, either
absolute or by way of mortgage, does not, as against the other partners, entitle the
assignee, during the continuance of the partnership, to interfere in the management
or administration of the partnership business or affairs, or to require any account
of the partnership transactions, or to inspect the partnership books, but entitles
the assignee only to receive the share of profits to which the assigning partner
would otherwise be entitled, and the assignee must accept the account of profits
agreed to by the partners.
(2) In case of a dissolution of the partnership, whether as respects all the
partners or as respects the assigning partner, the assignee is entitled to receive the
share of the partnership assets to which the assigning partner is entitled as between
himself and the other partners, and, for the purpose of ascertaining that share, to
an account as from the date of the dissolution.

Dissolution of Partnership and its Consequences

35 Dissolution by expiration or notice

(1) Subject to any agreement between the partners, a partnership is
dissolved –
(a) If entered into for a fixed term, by the expiration of that term;
(b) If entered into a single adventure or undertaking, by the termination
of that adventure or undertaking;
(c) If entered into for an undefined time, by any partner giving notice
to the other or others of his intention to dissolve the partnership.
(2) In subsection (1)(c) the partnership is dissolved as from the date
mentioned in the notice as the date of dissolution, or, if no date is so mentioned, as
from the date of the communication of the notice.

36 Dissolution by death, bankruptcy, or charge

(1) Subject to any agreement between the partners, every partnership is
dissolved as regards all the partners by the death or bankruptcy of any partner.
(2) A partnership may, at the option of the other partners, be dissolved if
any partner suffers his share of the partnership property to be charged under this
Act for his separate debt.

Partnership Act 1908

1385

37 Dissolution by illegality of partnership

A partnership is in every case dissolved by the happening of any event
which makes it unlawful for the business of the firm to be carried on or for the
members of the firm to carry it on in partnership.

38 Dissolution by the Court

On application by a partner the Court may declare a dissolution of the
partnership in any of the following cases –
(a) Where a partner is found lunatic by inquisition, or is shown to the
satisfaction of the Court to be of permanently unsound mind, in
either of which cases the application may be made as well on behalf
of that partner by his committee or next friend or person having
title to intervene as by any other partner;
(b) Where a partner, other than the partner suing, becomes in any other
way permanently incapable of performing his part of the
partnership contract;
(c) Where a partner, other than the partner suing, has been guilty of
such conduct as in the opinion of the Court, regard being had to
the nature of the business, is calculated to prejudicially affect the
carrying on of the business;
(d) Where a partner, other than the partner suing, wilfully or
persistently commits a breach of the partnership agreement, or
otherwise so conducts himself in matters relating to the partnership
business that it is not reasonably practicable for the other partner
or partners to carry on the business in partnership with him;
(e) Where the business of the partnership can only be carried on at a
loss;
(f) Where circumstances have arisen which, in the opinion of the Court,
render it just and equitable that the partnership be dissolved.

39 Rights of persons dealing with firm against apparent members

(1) Where a person deals with a firm after a change in its constitution, he
is entitled to treat all apparent members of the old firm as still being members of
the firm until he has notice of the change.
(2) An advertisement in the Gazette shall be notice as to persons who had
not dealings with the firm before the date of the dissolution or change so advertised.
(3) The estate of a partner who dies, or who becomes bankrupt, or of a
partner who, not having been known to the person dealing with the firm to be a
partner, retires from the firm, is not liable for partnership debts contracted after
the date of the death, bankruptcy, or retirement respectively.

40 Right of partners to notify dissolution

On the dissolution of a partnership or retirement of a partner any partner
may publicly notify the same, and may require the other partner or partners to
concur for that purpose in all necessary or proper acts, if any, which cannot be
done without his or their concurrence.

41 Continuing authority of partners for purposes of winding up

(1) After the dissolution of a partnership the authority of each partner to
bind the firm, and the other rights and obligations of the partners, continue
(notwithstanding the dissolution) so far as may be necessary to wind up the affairs
of the partnership and to complete transactions begun but unfinished at the time
of the dissolution, but not otherwise.
1386 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) The firm is in no case bound by the acts of a partner who has become bankrupt; but this proviso does not affect the liability of any person who has after the bankruptcy represented himself, or knowingly suffered himself to be represented, as a partner of the bankrupt.

42 Rights of partners as to application of partnership property

On the dissolution of a partnership every partner is entitled as against the
other partners in the firm, and all persons claiming through them in respect of
their interests as partners, to have the property of that partnership applied in
payment of the debts and liabilities of the firm, and to have the surplus assets
after such payment applied in payment of what may be due to the partners
respectively after deducting what may be due from them as partners of the firm;
and for that purpose any partner or his representatives may, on the termination of
the partnership, apply to the Court to wind up the business and affairs of the
firm.

43 Apportionment of premium where partnership prematurely dissolved

Where one partner has paid a premium to another on entering into a
partnership for a fixed term, and the partnership is dissolved before the expiration
of that term otherwise than by the death of a partner, the Court may order the
repayment of the premium or of such part of it as it thinks just, having regard to
the terms of the partnership contract and to the length of time during which the
partnership has continued, unless –
(a) The dissolution is, in the judgment of the Court, wholly or chiefly
due to the misconduct of the partner who paid the premium; or
(b) The partnership has been dissolved by an agreement containing
no provision for a return of any part of the premium.

44 Rights where partnership dissolved for fraud or misrepresentation

Where a partnership contract is rescinded on the ground of the fraud or
misrepresentation of one of the parties to it, the party entitled to rescind is, without
prejudice to any other right, entitled –
(a) To a lien on or right of retention of the surplus of the partnership
assets, after satisfying the partnership liabilities, for any sum of
money paid by him for the purchase of a share in the partnership
and for any capital contributed by him; and
(b) To stand in the place of the creditors of the firm for any payments
made by him in respect of the partnership liabilities; and
(c) To be indemnified, by the person guilty of the fraud or making the
representation, against all the debts and liabilities of the firm.

45 Right of outgoing partner to share profits made after dissolution

(1) Where any member of a firm dies or otherwise ceases to be a partner
and the surviving or continuing partners carry on the business of the firm with is
capital or assets without any final settlement of accounts as between the firm and
the outgoing partner or his estate, then, in the absence of any agreement to the
contrary, the outgoing partner or his estate is entitled, at the opinion of himself or
his representative, to such share of the profits made since the dissolution as the
Court may find to be attributable to the use of his share of the partnership assets,
or the interest at the rate of 5 per cent per annum on the amount of his share of the
partnership assets.

Partnership Act 1908

1387
(2) Where by the partnership contract an option is given to surviving or continuing partners to purchase the interest of a deceased or outgoing partner, and that option is duly exercised, the estate of the deceased partner or the outgoing partner, or his estate, as the case may be, is not entitled to any further or other share of profits; but if any partner assuming to act in exercise of the option does not in all material respects comply with the terms of it he is liable to account under this section.

46 Retiring or deceased partner’s share to be a debt

Subject to any agreement between the partners, the amount due from
surviving or continuing partners to an outgoing partner or the representatives of
a deceased partner, in respect of the outgoing or deceased partner ’s share, is a
debt accruing at the date of the dissolution or death.

47 Distribution of assets on final settlement of accounts

In settling accounts between the partners after a dissolution of partnership
the following rules shall, subject to any agreement, be observed –
(a) Losses, including losses and deficiencies of capital, shall be paid
first out of profits, next out of capital, and lastly, if necessary, by the
partners individually in the proportion in which they were entitled
to share profits.
(b) The assets of the firm, including the sums (if any) contributed by
the partners to make up losses or deficiencies of capital, shall be
applied in the following manner and order –
(i) in paying the debts and liabilities of the firm to persons who
are not partners in it;
(ii) in paying to each partner rateably what is due from the firm to
him for advances as distinguished from capital;
(iii) in paying to each partner rateably what is due from the firm to
him in respect of capital;
(iv) the ultimate residue, if any, shall be divided among the partners
in the proportion which profits are divisible.
PART 2
SPECIAL PARTNERSHIPS

48 Part 1 not to affect special partnerships

Part 1 shall not affect special partnerships except in so far as the general
law relating to partners is declared by sections 49-67 to be applicable to special
partnerships.

49 Special partnerships may be formed, except for banking and insurance (1) Special partnerships may be formed for the transaction of agriculture, mining, mercantile, mechanical, manufacturing, or other business, by any number of persons, upon the terms and subject to the conditions and liabilities prescribed

in this Part.
(2) Nothing shall authorise any such partnership for the purpose either of
banking or insurance.
1388 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

50 General and special partners, and their liabilities

Every special partnership may consist of general partners, who shall be
jointly and severally responsible as general partners are now by law, and of persons,
to be called special partners, who shall contribute to the common stock specific
sums in money as capital, beyond which they shall not be responsible for any
debt of the partnership except in cases provided in this Part.

51 Certificates to be signed by partners

All the persons forming any special partnership shall, before commencing
business, sign a certificate containing –
(a) The style of the firm under which the partnership is to be conducted;
(b) The names and places of residence of all the partners, distinguishing
the general from the special partners;
(c) The amount of capital which each special partner contributes, and
also (if any) the amount contributed by the general partners to the
common stock;
(d) The general nature of the business to be transacted;
(e) The principal or only place at which it is to be transacted; and
(f) The time when such partnership is to commence and when it is to
terminate.

52 Style of partnership

Such style or firm shall contain the names of general partners only, or the
name of one such partner, with (in either case) the addition of the words “and
Company”, and the general partners only shall transact the business of the
partnership.

53 When special partner deemed general partner

If in carrying on such business or in any contract connected with it the
name of any special partner is used with his consent or privity, or if he personally
makes any contract respecting the concerns of the partnership, he shall be deemed
to be a general partner with respect to the contract or matter in which his name
has been so used or as to which he so contracted.

54 Certificates to be acknowledged and registered

A special partnership shall not be deemed formed until such certificate is
acknowledged by each partner before the Court, and registered in the office of the
Court in a book to be kept for that purpose by the Registrar open to public
inspection.

55 False statement in certificate: partners liable as general partners

(1) If any false statement is made in any such certificate, all the persons
interested in the special partnership shall be liable for all the engagements thereof
as general partners.
(2) No clerical error or matter not of substance shall be deemed false within
the meaning of this section unless some person is prejudiced thereby, in which
case the special partners shall be liable to the person so prejudiced.

Partnership Act 1908

1389

56 Copy of certificate to be published

(1) A copy of such certificate shall be published once at least in the Gazette
and twice in some newspaper published at the intended principal place of business
of the special partnership, or at the nearest place to such place of business where
a newspaper is published.
(2) If such publication is not so made, the partnership shall be deemed
general.

57 Duration of partnerships

A special partnership shall not be entered into for a longer period than 7
years, but any such partnership may be renewed at the end of that period or at the
termination of any shorter period for which it was formed.

58 Certificate to be signed on renewal

(1) Upon every renewal or continuation beyond the time originally agreed
on for the duration of a special partnership, a certificate thereof shall be signed,
acknowledged, registered and published in like manner as the original certificate.
(2) Every partnership renewed or continued otherwise than in conformity
with this section shall be deemed general.

59 Capital stock not to be withdrawn

During the continuance of any special partnership no part of the certified
capital thereof shall be withdrawn, nor shall any division or interest or profit be
made so as to reduce such capital below the aggregate amount stated in the
certificate.

60 When special partners liable to refund capital withdrawn

(1) If any part of such capital is withdrawn, or any such division is made,
so that at any time during the continuance or at the termination of the special
partnership the assets are insufficient to pay the partnership debts, the special
partners shall be severally liable to refund every sum received by them respectively
in diminution of such capital or by way of such interest or profit.
(2) All such sums may be recovered as money had and received by the
respectively to the use of the general partners; and may in the case of any judgment
being obtained against the general partners, be recovered by the plaintiff against
the special partners, or any of them, by process of execution issued under such
judgment by leave of the Court.

61 Suits to be by and against general partners

All suits respecting the business of any special partnership shall be
prosecuted by and against the general partners only, except in the cases in which
it is provided by this Act that special partners shall or may be deemed general
partners, in which cases every special partner who becomes liable as a general
partner may be joined or not in the action as a defendant, at the discretion of the
party suing.

62 Dissolution, how effected

A dissolution of a special partnership shall not take place, except by
operation of law, before the time specified in the certificate, unless a notice of such
dissolution is signed, acknowledged, registered, and published in like manner as
the original certificate.
1390 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

63 Cases not specially provided for

In all cases not otherwise provided for all the members of a special
partnership shall be subject to the liabilities and entitled to the rights of general
partners.

64 Accounting

The general partners shall be liable to account to each other and to the
special partners for their management of the partnership concerns as other partners
are by law.

65 Frauds by partners

Every partner guilty of any fraud in the affairs of the partnership shall be
liable civilly to the party injured to the extent of his damage, and shall also be
liable to an indictment for a crime punishable by fine or imprisonment, or both, at
the discretion of the Court.

66 Books of account to be kept, and to be open to inspection

If the general partners do not at all times cause regular books of account to
be kept, or do not have the same open at all reasonable times to the inspection of
the special partners, such special partners shall be entitled to have the special
partnership dissolved and the accounts of it taken by the Court.

67 Liability of special partners if books not kept

If the books of any special partnership are, with the knowledge or privity
of the special partners or any of them, kept incorrectly, or contain any false or
deceptive entries, whereby the ascertainment of the matters mentioned in sections
59 and 60 are or may be affected, the certified capital of such special partners or
such one or more of them having such knowledge or privity shall as against
creditors be deemed to have been withdrawn, and they or he shall be liable
accordingly under section 60.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE [Not reproduced]

1391

PARTNERSHIP APPLICATION ACT 1994

1994/180 – 28 March 1994

1

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

Short title

11

PART 3

LIMITED LIABILITY PARTNERSHIPS

Appointment of Registrar

2

Interpretation

12

Application for registration

13

Annual certificates of registration

PART 2

14

Address for service

GENERAL AND SPECIAL PARTNERSHIPS

15

Display name

3

Partnership Act

16

Liability for debts

4

17

Power of partner to bind the partnership

5

Formation

18

Jurisdiction

6

Special partnerships

19

No separate legal entity

7

Penalties

20

Assignment

8

Regulations

21

Secrecy

9

Partnership interests

22

Translations

10

Passive income

23

No action to lie against certain persons

24

Power of exemption

25

Prohibitions by the Minister

1 Short title


PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Partnership Application Act 1994.

2 Interpretation

“Deputy Registrar” means a deputy registrar of limited liability
partnerships appointed under section 11;
“Minister” means the Minister of Justice;
“Registrar” means a registrar of limited liability partnerships appointed
under section 11.

3 Partnership Act

(1) [Spent]
PART 2
GENERAL AND SPECIAL PARTNERSHIPS
(2) References in the Partnership Act 1908 to the High Court are to the High Court of Niue with respect to a partnership formed in Niue, unless the partners of that partnership unanimously agree that such references are to the High Court of New Zealand.
1392 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
of partnership constituting that partnership is executed or signed in Niue by all the partners of it or by their duly appointed attorneys.

6 Special partnerships

(1) Any partner of a special partnership formed in Niue under Part 2 of
the Partnership Act 1908 who would be a general partner solely by virtue of the
operation of section 53 of the Partnership Act 1908 shall be deemed to be a special
partner notwithstanding that section if the making of any contract by that partner
respecting the concerns of the partnership, or the use or consensual use of that
partner ’s name in relation to the carrying on of the business of the partnership or
any contract connected with it, is directly related to a business principally carried
on outside Niue.
(2) Section 57 of the Partnership Act 1908 shall not apply to limit the
duration of any special partnership formed in Niue under Part 2 of the Partnership
Act 1908 to any period.

7 Penalties

Any person who –
(a) Does anything which is forbidden by or under this Act; or
(b) Omits to do something required or directed by or under this Act; or
(c) Contravenes or fails to comply with this Act,
shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding
50 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year or to both.

8 Regulations

Cabinet may make Regulations prescribing all matters and things required
or authorised by this Act to be prescribed or which are necessary for carrying out
or giving effect to this Act including the prescribing of penalties for breaches of
such Regulations not exceeding a fine of 100 penalty units.

9 Partnership interests

(1) A partnership (“the first partnership”) may be a partner in another
partnership (“the second partnership”) in which case the members of the first
partnership shall become individual members of the second partnership, excepting
that for the purposes of determining the rights of the partners of the second
partnership inter se and for the purposes of Part III they shall be deemed to be one
person. Nothing in this subsection applies to, or prevents, a partner in a partnership
creating a sub-partnership in equity of his legal interest as regards either his capital
or income or both.
(2) A person may assign in equity any legal or equitable interest in
partnership capital or income, or both, providing the assignment is in writing and
is unconditional.
(3) Subsection (2) shall apply both to present property, being a present
right to receive future income and to future property, being the income to be
received in the future.

Partnership Application Act 1994

1393

10 Passive income

(1) Persons who are jointly in receipt of passive income from any
investment and who carry on no business in respect of that investment other than
the raising of capital in relation to it, the taking of accounts in respect of it, and the
contracting for maintenance for it are deemed not to be partners by virtue of such
joint receipt.
(2) Passive income from any investment shall for the purposes of this
section include any income derived from any interest as a beneficiary under a
trust, and any income derived from the holding of any income-producing property,
providing always that the expenditure referred to in subsection (1) does not in
any 3 year period exceed 15 per cent of the total income derived from that interest
or property in that period before taking into account capital costs (and interest on
it) with respect to it.
(3) Income-producing property shall for the purposes of this section include
any intellectual property rights or now-how which generate income, providing
that any services supplied in relation to or in conjunction with the income thereby
generated does not in any 3 year period exceed 15 per cent in value of the total
income derived from that interest or property in that period.
(4) This section shall not apply to any persons who are jointly in receipt of
passive income from any investment and who enter into any deed or written
Agreement of Partnership with each other, whose status shall thereafter be
determined under the general law.
PART 3
LIMITED LIABILITY PARTNERSHIPS

11 Appointment of Registrar

(1) There shall be appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission on
the advice of Cabinet –
(a) A Registrar of limited liability partnerships to carry out the duties
and functions vested in him by or under this Act;
(b) Such Deputy Registrars of limited liability partnerships and other
officers as are required for the purposes of this Act.
(2) Anything by this Act appointed or authorised or required to be done
by the Registrar may be done by any such Deputy Registrar and shall be as valid
and effectual as if done by the Registrar, and the term Registrar shall for the
remainder of this Act be deemed to include any Deputy Registrar.
(3) All courts, judges, and persons acting judicially shall take judicial notice
of the seal and also the signature of the Registrar.
(4) For the purposes of ascertaining whether a limited liability partnership
is complying with this Part the Registrar or any person authorised by him may
inspect any book, minute book, register or record kept by the limited liability
partnership.
(5) Any person appointed under subsection (1) who except for the purposes
of this Act or except in the course of criminal proceedings makes a record of,
divulges or communicates to any other person any information which he possesses
or has acquired –
(a) By reason of his carrying out the duties and functions of his office;
or
(b) By reason of access forwarded or obtained by him to any document
or register kept by the Registrar or book, minute book, register or
record kept by any limited liability partnership,
1394 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
shall be guilty of an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding
50 penalty units or to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 2 years in respect of
each such offence.

12 Application for registration

(1) Any partnership formed in Niue that is not a special partnership formed
of the Partnership Act 1908 under Part 2 may apply to the Registrar for registration
as a limited liability partnership.
(2) Any application of the kind referred to in subsection (1) shall be on a
form prescribed by the Minister and shall be accompanied by the prescribed fee.
(3) Every such application shall be signed by all the partners to the
partnership, and every such application shall specify a partner of the partnership
or a duly appointed attorney thereof such that the registered office of the
partnership shall be the address in Niue of that partner or duly appointed attorney.
(4) Every such application shall contain a several guarantee from the
partners in prescribed form to all creditors of the partnership limited to such sum
as the partners shall nominate, being not less than $250 in it per partner.
(5) A deed or written Agreement of Partnership shall accompany every
such application and shall be stamped by the Registrar with a registration number
when the application is accepted in proper form and the prescribed fee is paid.
(6) Upon stamping of the deed or written Agreement of Partnership under
subsection (5) the Registrar shall return the deed or written Agreement of
Partnership to the registered office of the partnership and shall register that
partnership upon a Register of limited liability partnerships kept for that purpose
and issue a certificate of registration in the prescribed form.
(7) A limited liability partnership is deemed to be registered under this
section from the date upon which the deed or written Agreement of Partnership
is stamped under subsection (5), and the date of registration specified in the
certificate of registration issued under subsection (6) shall be that date.
(8) A partnership shall not be deemed to be formed as a limited liability
partnership until it is registered under this section or with section 13.

13 Annual certificates of registration

(1) A certificate of registration issued under section 12(6) shall be valid
and effective for one year from the date of registration specified in that certificate.
(2) Application for renewal of registration may be made upon filing with
the Registrar an application for renewal of registration on a form prescribed by
the Minister and payment of the prescribed fee.
(3) No application for renewal of registration under subsection (2) shall be
granted where the application is filed or fee paid after the date of expiry of the last
certificate of registration.
(4) Every renewal of registration shall be for a period of one year from the
date of expiry of the last certificate of registration.

14 Address for service

The address for service of any documents upon a limited liability
partnership shall be the registered office of that partnership.

15 Display name

Every limited liability partnership shall have its name displayed on the
outside of its registered office in a conspicuous position in letters easily legible.

Partnership Application Act 1994

1395

16 Liability for debts

(1) (a) Subject to subsection (2), in determining the extent of any liability
for the debts of a limited liability partnership the partners of a
limited liability partnership shall each be severally liable for the
debts of the partnership only to the extent of the amount nominated
by each of them in the guarantee lodged with the application
referred to in section 12 (4).
(b) Nothing in this subsection shall apply to prevent any security given
in respect of any property being enforced, nor any personal
guarantee given by any partner being sued upon.
(2) Subsection (1) shall not apply –
(a) To any debt arising from a transaction entered into by a limited
liability partnership with a person or persons resident in Niue unless
the fact that the partnership is registered as a limited liability
partnership is acknowledged in writing by the other person or
persons prior to the parties to the transaction being bound to it;
(b) To any debt existing at the date of first registration of the limited
liability partnership under section 12.

17 Power of partner to bind the partnership

Every partner of a limited liability partnership is an agent of the limited
liability partnership and the other partners in it for the purposes of the business
of the limited liability partnership, and the acts of every partner who does any act
for carrying on in the usual way business of the kind carried on by the limited
liability partnership shall, subject to section 16, bind the limited liability partnership
and the other partners in it, unless the partner so acting has in fact no authority to
act for the limited liability partnership in the particular matter, and the person
with whom the partner is dealing either knows that the partner has no authority
or does not know or believe that person to be a partner.

18 Jurisdiction

Every limited liability partnership shall be subject to the exclusive
jurisdiction of the High Court of Niue unless the partners otherwise provide at
the time of entering into binding legal relations, with third parties or with each
other, with respect to such legal relations.

19 No separate legal entity

Nothing in this Part shall be taken to alter the laws of partnership applying
to partnerships generally so as to constitute any limited liability partnership a
legal entity separate from its members, and for the avoidance of doubt a limited
liability partnership cannot sue or be sued in its own name.

20 Assignment

Unless otherwise agreed in writing by all the partners of a limited liability
partnership a partner in that partnership will not by assigning all his interest in
that partnership to another person thereby dissolve that partnership and that
partnership shall upon such an assignment occurring be deemed to have always
consisted of its present partners excepting that –
(a) Any person to whom a partnership interest has been assigned shall
be liable under the guarantee given under section 12 (4) by the
assignor (or his predecessor in title (being the person who signed
the guarantee)) and the assignor shall be released from the same;
1396 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) The proviso to section 16 (1) shall continue to apply to both the assignor and the assignee;
(c) For the purposes of any action between the partners inter se only those partners who were partners at the time the relevant cause of action arose shall be parties to any such action.

21 Secrecy

(1) Except where this Act requires, and subject to subsection (2), it shall be
an offence for any person to divulge or communicate to any other person
information relating to the establishment, constitution, business, undertaking or
affairs of a limited liability partnership.
(2) All judicial proceedings, other than criminal proceedings, relating to
limited liability partnerships shall, unless ordered otherwise, be heard in camera
and no details of the proceedings shall be published by any person without leave
of the Court or person presiding.
(3) Notwithstanding subsection (1), an offence shall not be committed
where information is divulged or made available to the extent reasonably required
in the circumstances to any foreign government or any court or tribunal of any
country including Niue but only if and to the extent that the High Court of Niue
so directs, having been satisfied that the information is required and will be used
solely for the purposes of an investigation or prosecution of any person in relation
to the sale, or the laundering of the proceeds of sale, of any prohibited narcotic
substances, or the laundering of the proceeds gained from any other serious
criminal activity, whether that sale or laundering or other serious criminal activity
occurred in Niue or elsewhere.
(4) Nothing in this section shall prevent the High Court of Niue from
requiring any person to produce documents or to give evidence in any proceedings
of any facts relevant in such proceedings in a court in Niue.

22 Translations

(1) Every document filed with the Registrar under this Part and not in the
English language shall be accompanied by a certified translation.
(2) A document that is not in the English language and which is not
accompanied by a certified translation at the time of filing shall not be accepted
for registration by the Registrar.
(3) For the purpose of this section a certified translation is a translation
into the English language, certified as a correct translation, by a translator to the
satisfaction of the Registrar.

23 No action to lie against certain persons

Notwithstanding section 21 no action shall lie against the Government of
Niue, any statutory body or authority or a public or judicial officer in respect of
the performance of its or his functions or duties under this Part.

24 Power of exemption

(1) Cabinet may, on the advice of the Minister, on its own motion or under
an application in writing lodged with the Registrar by a limited liability partnership
or a partnership which would be a limited liability partnership if it were registered,
exempt that limited liability partnership or partnership from all or any of the
provisions of this Act and any Regulations made under this Act and may impose
such terms and conditions as it thinks fit as a condition under which that exemption
is granted.

Partnership Application Act 1994

1397
(2) Any exemption granted under subsection (1) may be revoked or varied by Cabinet, on the advice of the Minister, at any time.
(3) In dealing with an application under this section Cabinet shall not be required to act judicially and its decision shall in all cases be final.
(4) Any exemption or condition imposed under subsection (1) shall take effect as from a date to be decided by the Cabinet in its discretion.

25 Prohibitions by the Minister

(1) Cabinet shall, on the advice of the Minister, have an absolute right and
without assigning reasons to make an order –
(a) Prohibiting the registration of any partnership as a limited liability
partnership; or
(b) Directing any limited liability partnership to cease carrying on its
business or part of its business immediately or within such time as
may be specified in the order.
(2) Any order made under this section may be revoked or varied by the
Cabinet, on the advice of the Minister.
(3) In making an order under this section the Cabinet shall not be required
to act judicially and such order shall be final.

1398 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1399

PENSIONS AND BENEFITS ACT 1991

1991/157 – 1 October 1991

1

Short title

12

Provision for welfare benefit

2

Interpretation

13

Rate of welfare benefit

PART 1

PART 3

PENSIONS

GENERAL PROVISIONS

3

Entitlement to a pension

14

Moneys payable out of the Government

4

Rate of pension

Account

15

Payment of pension or welfare benefit in

PART 2

special circumstances

WELFARE BENEFITS

16

Recovery of payments in excess

5

Welfare Committee

17

Offences

6

Meetings of Committee

18

Taxation

7

Delegation of powers of Committee

19

Regulations

8

Application for welfare benefit

20-21 [Spent]

9

Investigation of applications

10

Criteria for receipt of welfare benefit

SCHEDULE

11

Maintenance

To consolidate and amend the law relating to the provision of pensions and benefits in Niue

1 Short title

This is the Pensions and Benefits Act 1991.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Committee” means the Welfare Committee established by section 5;
“destitute person” and “infirm person” means any person who is unable
to support himself by his own means or labour, and includes persons
with dependents where such dependants are unable through infirmity
or age to support themselves by their own means or labour;
“Director” means the Director of Community Affairs;
“permanent resident” means any person who has been granted permanent
resident status under section 6 of the Entry, Residence and Departure
Act 1985.
1400 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

3 Entitlement to a pension

(1) Every person who is –
PART 1
PENSIONS
(a) Of the age of 60 years or more; and
(b) Every Niuean and permanent resident in Niue and has been so
resident for not less than 6 months immediately preceding the date
on which the application is made;
shall, on application to the Director, be entitled subject to this Act, to receive a
pension.
(1A) Notwithstanding subsection (1), every person who is –
(a) Of the age of 55 years; and
(b) Either a Niuean or permanent resident in Niue and has been so
resident for not less than 10 years immediately preceding the date
on which application is made,
shall on application to the Director, be entitled subject to this Act to receive half of
the fortnightly pension entitlement until reaching the age of 60 years.
(2) For the purposes of this section, residence in Niue shall be deemed not
to have been interrupted in any case where such interruption was due to absence
for –
(a) The purpose of the applicant undergoing medical or surgical treatment for a period not exceeding 6 months, and the Director is satisfied that there was good and sufficient reason for leaving Niue to obtain that treatment;
(b) The purpose of undertaking a course of education or training; (c) Service overseas by the applicant for the Government of Niue.
(3) Notwithstanding subsection (1), every person who is in receipt of a
pension shall, upon being absent from Niue for any period in excess of 3 months,
cease to be entitled to receive a pension, but shall on returning to take up residence
in Niue, be entitled to re-apply for, and receive a pension.
(4) The payment of a pension shall cease immediately on the death of the
recipient.
(5) A recipient can only be entitled to one pension, funded either locally or
from overseas, but not both.

4 Rate of pension

The rate of pension payable shall be prescribed by Cabinet.

5 Welfare Committee

PART 2
WELFARE BENEFITS
(1) For the purposes of this Part there shall be a committee called the Welfare
Committee.
(2) The Committee shall consist of –
(a) The Director;
(b) The Director of Health; and
(c) A person appointed by and at the pleasure of Cabinet.
(3) The Director shall be Chairman of the Committee and shall preside at
all meetings at which he is present.
(4) In the absence of the Chairman the Director of Health shall act as
Chairman.

Pensions and Benefits Act 1991

1401
(5) At any meeting of the Committee the Chairman or as the case may be the acting chairman shall have a deliberative vote and in the case of an equality of votes shall also have a casting vote.

6 Meetings of Committee

(1) The Committee shall sit at such times and places as it may determine.
(2) At any meeting of the Committee 2 members shall form a quorum.

7 Delegation of powers of Committee

(1) The Committee may either generally or particularly delegate to the
Director, such of its powers as the Committee determines.
(2) Subject to this section and to any general or special directions given or
conditions attached by the Committee, the Director to whom any powers are
delegated under this section may exercise those powers in the same manner and
with the same effect as if they had been conferred on the Director directly by this
section.
(3) Every person purporting to act under any delegation under this section
shall be presumed to be acting under the terms of the delegation in the absence of
proof of the contrary.
(4) Any delegation under this section may at any time be revoked by the
Committee in whole or in part, and no such delegation shall prevent the exercise
of any power by the Committee.

8 Application for welfare benefit

Every person who has been ordinarily resident in Niue for not less than 10
years immediately preceding the date of the application, and who is a destitute
person or an infirm person, may apply in writing to the Committee for a welfare
benefit.

9 Investigation of applications

(1) The Director shall cause every application for a welfare benefit to be
investigated and a report on it to be made to the Committee for deliberation and
decision.
(2) It shall be the duty of every person to answer all questions put by or on
behalf of the Director in connection with an application.

10 Criteria for receipt of welfare benefit

(1) On receipt of an application for a welfare benefit, and the report required
to be furnished under section 9(1), the Committee shall as soon as practicable
consider the application, taking into account such matters as the Committee thinks
fit, including –
(a) The financial circumstances of the applicant;
(b) The health of the applicant;
(c) Such other matters as may be prescribed by Cabinet.
(2) On receipt of an application for a welfare benefit, the Committee shall,
in addition to the matters set out in subsection (1), consider the possibility of
rehabilitating the applicant, or of assisting the applicant to find employment, or
undergoing medical treatment, or counselling.
(3) Any applicant who without reasonable excuse refuses to act on any
advice or counselling given to him by the Committee consequent upon any matters
considered by the Committee under subsection (2), shall not be entitled to receive
a welfare benefit or, if he is already in receipt of such a benefit, such benefit may
be reduced, or terminated forthwith by the Committee.
1402 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

11 Maintenance

In considering any application for a welfare benefit the Committee shall, in
addition to the matters set forth in section 10, have regard to Part 23 of the Niue
Act 1966, and may refuse to grant any welfare benefit to an applicant if the
Committee is satisfied that proceedings on behalf of the applicant should first be
taken to recover maintenance under that Part, and the Director is hereby
empowered in the name of the applicant to make application to the Court and to
prosecute any application which may be made or instituted by any other person
under section 549 of the Niue Act 1966.

12 Provision for welfare benefit

(1) On approval of any application the Committee shall in the first instance,
approve the payment of a welfare benefit for a period not exceeding 6 months.
(2) On the expiry of 6 months, or such shorter period for which the payment
of a welfare benefit may have been approved in the first instance, application for
continuation of the benefit for a further period not exceeding 6 months may be
made by the recipient in the same manner as the original application.
(3) After 2 successive successful applications by the recipient of a benefit,
the Committee may grant a benefit for longer periods not exceeding one year on
such terms as it may decide.
(4) A welfare benefit shall be paid in such amount, not exceeding the
maximum rate of benefit payable prescribed under section 13, as the Committee
may determine.
(5) Payment of a welfare benefit under any grant shall cease immediately
on –
(a) The death of the recipient;
(b) The circumstances which entitled the recipient to a welfare benefit
ceasing to exist;
(c) The recipient being absent from Niue for any period in excess of 3
months, provided that such recipient may, on returning to take up
residence in Niue, reapply for a welfare benefit.
(6) A welfare benefit shall be paid at such intervals, and upon such terms
and conditions as the Committee may decide.

13 Rate of welfare benefit

The maximum rate of welfare benefit payable shall be prescribed by Cabinet.
PART 3
GENERAL PROVISIONS

14 Money payable out of the Government Account

There shall be paid out of the Niue Government Account from money
appropriated by the Assembly for the purpose –
(a) All money required to be expended in providing pensions or welfare
benefits under Part 1 and Part 2; and
(b) All other money that may be appropriated by the Assembly for the
purposes of Part 1 and Part 2, or that may be appropriated for any
purpose incidental or related to the purposes of Part 1 and Part 2.

Pensions and Benefits Act 1991

1403

15 Payment of pension or welfare benefit in special circumstances

Notwithstanding any other provision in this Act, Cabinet may approve the
payment of a pension or of a welfare benefit to any person who is ordinarily
resident in Niue and who would not otherwise qualify under this Act for the
payment to him of a pension or welfare benefit where –
(a) In the case of a pension, Cabinet is satisfied that the person to whom
the pension is to be paid is of the age of 60 years or more;
(b) In the case of a welfare benefit, Cabinet is satisfied that the person
to whom the benefit is to be paid is a destitute or infirm person;
and in either case, Cabinet is satisfied on the merits of the case that special
circumstances exist to warrant such payment.

16 Recovery of payments in excess

If any pension or welfare benefit, or instalment of it, or any money is paid
to any person under this Act in excess of the amount which ought to have been
paid to such person, the excess so paid may be –
(a) Recovered by the Director as a debt due to the Crown; or
(b) Recovered by the Director by any necessary adjustment to or
deduction from any instalments of the same or any other pension
or welfare benefit being paid to that person;
(c) Deducted by the Financial Secretary from any other money of
whatsoever kind payable or due from the Government to that
person.

17 Offences

Every person commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine
not exceeding 2 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months
who –
(a) For the purpose of obtaining any pension or welfare benefit under this Act for himself or for any other person, makes any false statement to, or otherwise misleads or attempts to mislead any officer concerned in the administration of this Act, or any other person whomsoever;
(b) Being a person engaged in the administration of this Act, demands or receives from an applicant for a pension or a welfare benefit or any other person, any fee or other consideration for procuring or attempting to procure any pension or welfare benefit.

18 Taxation

No person shall be liable for income tax in respect of a pension or a welfare
benefit paid under this Act.

19 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make regulations providing for such matters as are
contemplated by or necessary for giving full effect to this Act and for the due
administration of it.
(2) Regulations made under this section may provide for offences against
such regulations punishable by a term of imprisonment not exceeding 3 months
or a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or both.

20-21 [Spent]

1404 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1405

PESTICIDES ACT 1991

1991/158 – 1 October 1991

1

Short title

2

Interpretation

3

Power to declare substances to be

pesticides

4

Pesticides Committee

5

Functions and powers of Committee

6

Exemptions

7

Importation of pesticides

8

Application for permit to import pesticide

9

Sale and distribution of pesticides

To regulate the importation and sale of pesticides

1 Short title

This is the Pesticides Act 1991.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“brand” means the trade name applied to a pesticide of any description by
the manufacturer, importer, seller or distributor;
“Committee” means the Pesticides Committee established under section
4;
“container” includes anything in or by which pesticides may be cased,
covered, enclosed, contained or packed;
“Director” means the Director of Agriculture, Forestry and Fisheries or such
other person as (being an officer of the Department of Agriculture
Forestry and Fisheries) to whom the functions of the Director under
this Act may for the time being have been delegated by the Director;
“label” means any written, printed or graphic matter on, attached to, the
pesticide or the container of it and the outside container of the retail
package of the pesticide;
“Minister” means the Minister for the time being responsible for agriculture;
“permit to import” means a permit issued under section 8;
“permit to sell” means a permit issued under section 10;
“pest” means any form of plant or animal life or any pathogenic agent
injurious or potentially injurious to plant or animal life and includes
any public health pest, but does not include any such pest living on or
in humans;
1406 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“pesticide” means –
(i) any substance or mixture of substances used for preventing,
destroying or controlling any pest, including vectors or human
and animal disease, unwanted species of plants or animals
causing harm during or otherwise interfering with production,
processing, storage, transport or marketing of food agricultural
commodities, wood and wood products or animal foodstuffs;
or which may be administered to animals for the control of
insects, arachnids or other pests in or on their bodies; and
(ii) includes substances or mixture of substances intended for use
as a plant growth regulator, defoliant, desiccant or agent for
thinning fruit or preventing the premature fall of fruit and
substances applied to crops either before or after harvest to
protect the commodity from deterioration during storage and
transport;
(iii) includes any substance or mixture of substances declared by
Cabinet under section 3 to be a pesticide.

3 Power to declare substances to be pesticides

(1) Cabinet may on the recommendation of the Committee declare any
substance or mixture of substances to be a pesticide for the purposes of this Act
and in the like manner, may revoke such declaration.
(2) Any such declaration may relate to any substance or mixture specified
by its common name or brand, or to any class of substances or mixture identified
by a description of that class.
(3) Any such substance or mixture or class of substances or mixtures may
be identified by reference to its toxicological action, its use, or its intended purpose.

4 Pesticides Committee

(1) For the purposes of this Act there shall be constituted a committee to
be called the Pesticides Committee.
(2) The Committee shall consist of –
(a) The Director who shall be Chairman of the Committee;
(b) The Director of Health;
(c) One person appointed by and to hold office at the pleasure of
Cabinet, who shall be a person who in the opinion of Cabinet,
represents the interests of pesticide importers and sellers;
(d) One person appointed by and to hold office at the pleasure of
Cabinet, who shall be a person who in the opinion of Cabinet,
represents the interests of pesticide users.
(3) The Committee shall meet when required by the Minister or the
Chairman but in any event not less than 4 times in every year.
(4) Subject to this Act the Committee may regulate its own procedure as it
thinks fit, including the appointment of technical advisers and temporary members.
(5) The Chairman at any meeting of the Committee shall have a casting
vote as well as a deliberative vote.

5 Functions and powers of the Committee

The Committee shall have all the functions and powers necessary for the
administration of this Act, including the function and power to –
(a) Assess and evaluate every application made under this Act for the
importation or sale of a pesticide;

Pesticides Act 1991 1407

(b) Determine in its discretion the conditions relating to the importation or sale of any pesticide;
(c) Suspend or revoke subject to this Act, any permit issued under this
Act;
(d) Promote the efficient, prudent and safe use of pesticides by the
public generally;
(e) Advise Cabinet and the Minister on pesticide-related matters.

6 Exemptions

Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act, Cabinet may, on the
recommendation of the Committee, exempt any pesticide from one or more of the
provisions of this Act and may in like manner revoke any such exemption.

7 Importation of pesticides

No person shall import into Niue any pesticide, except under the terms
and conditions of a permit issued under section 8.

8 Application for permit to import pesticide

(1) Every application to import a pesticide shall be lodged with the Director
in writing.
(2) Every application made under this section shall state full particulars of

(a) The name and address of the applicant and the name and address
of the manufacturer or distributor of the pesticide;
(b) The brand name and percentage by weight or volume of every active
ingredient contained in the pesticide;
(c) The nature and formulation of the pesticide;
(d) The labelling which it is proposed to use on the pesticide container;
(e) The purpose for which the pesticide is normally used;
(f) The storage facilities available to the applicant for the keeping of
the pesticide.
(3) On receipt of an application for importation of a pesticide, the Director
shall refer the application to the Committee who shall –
(a) Approve the application either wholly or in part, and either with
or without such conditions as the Committee thinks fit; or
(b) Defer the application until further relevant information required
by the Committee is provided; or
(c) Decline the application.
(4) Without limiting the generality of the conditions which the Committee
may impose under subsection (3)(a) the Committee may, when approving an
application for the importation of a pesticide impose conditions relating to –
(a) The quantity of any pesticide which may be imported pursuant to
the permit;
(b) The period of time for which the permit shall remain valid, being
in any event not longer than 2 years;
(c) The methods to be used when handling the pesticide;
(d) The premises where the pesticide is to be stored, including the type
and condition of those premises, the extent and type of security
measures which will be taken, and whether any other type of goods
will be stored in or about those same premises.
(5) Every permit issued under this section shall be in writing under the
hand of the Director, and shall be in such form as the Committee may approve.
1408 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

9 Sale and distribution of pesticides

No person shall sell or distribute in Niue, any pesticide to any other person,
except under the terms and conditions of a permit issued under section 10.

10 Application for permit to sell or distribute pesticide

(1) Every application to sell or distribute a pesticide shall be lodged with
the Director in writing.
(2) Every application made under this section shall state full particulars of

(a) The name and address of the applicant;
(b) The brand name of the pesticide which the applicant proposes to
sell;
(c) Whether or not the applicant is the importer of the pesticide, and if
not, the person from whom the pesticide is to be obtained;
(d) The premises where the pesticide will be stored, including the type
and condition of those premises, the extent and type of security
measures which will be taken, and the storage of the pesticide in
relation to the proximity of other types of goods;
(e) The label to be affixed to any container containing the pesticide;
(f) The purpose for which the pesticide is normally used.
(3) On receipt of an application to sell or distribute a pesticide, the Director
shall refer the application to the Committee, who shall –
(a) Approve the application either wholly or in part, and either with
or without such conditions as the Committee thinks fit; or
(b) Defer the application until further relevant information required
by the Committee is provided; or
(c) Decline the application.
(4) Without limiting the generality of the conditions which the Committee
may impose under subsection (3)(a), the Committee may, when approving an
application to sell or distribute a pesticide impose conditions relating to –
(a) The period of time for which the permit shall remain valid, being
in any event not longer than 2 years;
(b) The methods to be used when handling the pesticide;
(c) The premises where the pesticide is to be stored, including the type
and condition of those premises, the extent and type of security
measures which are to be taken and the storage of the pesticide in
relation to the proximity of other types of goods;
(d) The label which is to be affixed on any container containing the
pesticide.
(5) Every permit issued under this section shall be in writing under the
hand of the Director, and shall be in such form as the Committee may approve.

11 Register of importers and sellers of pesticides

(1) The Director shall keep and maintain a register of all persons who have
been issued with a permit to import or a permit to sell.
(2) The register required to be kept and maintained under subsection (1)
shall include –
(a) The name and address of the permit-holder;
(b) The date on which the permit was issued by the Committee and
the date of its expiry;
(c) The brand name of the pesticide approved under the permit;
(d) The purpose for which the pesticide is ordinarily used;

Pesticides Act 1991 1409

(e) Any conditions which the Committee may have imposed in respect of the permit;
(f) Such further particulars as the Committee may require to be kept.

12 Customs not to release pesticides

The Revenue Manager shall not release any pesticide to any person
importing a pesticide unless the Revenue Manager is first satisfied that the importer
of the pesticide is the holder of a current permit to import in respect of that pesticide.

13 Revocation and suspension of permits

Notwithstanding the period of time for which any permit may have been
issued under section 8 or section 10, the Committee may, after giving the holder
of the permit a reasonable opportunity to be heard in relation to the matter –
(a) Revoke any permit where the holder of the permit has been
convicted of any offence under this Act; or
(b) Suspend any permit where a prosecution is pending in the Court
against the holder of the permit and the Committee is satisfied that
having regard to all the circumstances, the continued importation
or selling (as the case may be) of any pesticide under that permit
constitutes a danger to the health or safety of any person;
(c) Suspend or revoke any permit when facts not known to the
Committee at the time the permit was issued subsequently come to
the attention of the Committee, and the Committee is satisfied on
the basis of such facts that the continued importation or sale (as the
case may be) of that pesticide would give rise during normal use to
an unacceptable hazard to any person, any animal, or to the
environment.

14 Search and seizure

Where the Director has reasonable cause to suspect that an offence has been
or is about to be committed against this Act or any regulations made under this
Act, the Director or any person acting under the authority of the Director may,
during usual business hours and in the presence of a constable, without warrant
enter any premises and search them, and may –
(a) Seize or take samples of and remove any substance which the
Director has reasonable cause to suspect is a pesticide;
(b) Seize or take samples of and remove any document, container, or
other thing whatsoever which the Director has reasonable cause to
believe may be required as evidence for the purpose of proceedings
in respect of any such offence.

15 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person who –
(a) Imports a pesticide without first obtaining a permit under section
8, or
(b) Being the holder of a permit to import, imports a pesticide in
contravention of any condition attaching to such permit; or
(c) Sells or distributes any pesticide without first obtaining a permit
under section 10; or
(d) Being the holder of a permit to sell, sells or distributes any pesticide
in contravention of any condition attaching to such permit;
commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2
1410

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

penalty units for a first offence, and not exceeding 10 penalty units for a second or subsequent offence.
(2) Where any person is convicted of any offence under subsection (1), the Court may, in addition to the penalty prescribed under subsection (1), order that any pesticide in respect of which the offence has been committed shall be forfeited to the Crown, or disposed of in such other manner as the Court, after hearing submissions in relation to the matter, may direct.

16 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make regulations for the purpose of carrying out this Act.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), Cabinet may make
regulations prescribing –
(a) The form to be used for any application under section 8 or section
10 and the form of any permit which may be issued under those
sections;
(b) The fees to be paid in respect of any application under section 8 or
section 10 and for the issue of any permit under those sections;
(c) The terms and conditions subject to which any permit under section
8 or section 10 may be issued;
(d) Minimum standards to be observed by the holder of a permit to
import or a permit to sell in relation to the storage or handling of
any pesticide;
(e) Minimum standards to be observed by any user of any pesticide,
whether or not such users hold a permit to import or a permit to
sell under this Act;
(f) Offences for the non-observance or breach of any such regulations,
and penalties not exceeding a fine of 2 penalty units.
1411

PIG CONTROL ACT 1998

1998/231 – 5 June 1998

1

Short title

10

Constable may destroy a pig suffering from

2

Interpretation

injury

3

Owner of pig must not allow the pig to

11

Power of entry

wander at large

12

Power of constable to request information

4

Owner of pig to ensure that its enclosure is

13

Wilful obstruction of constable

not a nuisance

14

Court may order convicted person to pay

5

Owner of pig to ensure that the pig has

compensation

sufficient food and water

15

Owner liable for damage done by a pig

6

Owner of pig found wandering to

wandering at large

recapture pig

16

Indemnity

7

Owner of land may capture and destroy pig

17

Compensation not payable for destruction

wandering on land

of pig

8

Constable may be requested to capture

wandering pig

18

Regulations

9

Constable may destroy or capture pig

found wandering at large

1 Short title

This is the Pig Control Act 1998.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Chief of Police” includes a person for the time being carrying out the
duties of the Chief of Police;
“owner”, in respect of a pig or land, includes a person for the time being
having responsibility for the pig or land, and, in the case of land, also
includes any person who has an interest in the land.

3 Owner of pig must not allow the pig to wander at large

(1) The owner of a pig must ensure that the pig is –
(a) Kept in an enclosure; or
(b) Tethered,
in such a way that it cannot wander at large.
Penalty: (a) Fine not exceeding 2 penalty units; or
(b) If a person is convicted of an offence under this section
within one year after being convicted of an offence under
this section – 5 penalty units.
(2) It is not a defence for a person charged with an offence under subsection
(1) for the person to prove that the pig to which the charge relates was wandering
at large on land in which that person had an interest.
1412 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

4 Owner of pig to ensure that its enclosure is not a nuisance

The owner of a pig must ensure that any enclosure in which the pig is kept
is kept in such a condition that the enclosure does not become a nuisance or
annoyance to any other person.
Penalty: (a) Fine not exceeding 2 penalty units;
(b) If a person is convicted of an offence under this section within
one year after being convicted of an offence under this section
– 5 penalty units.

5 Owner of pig to ensure that the pig has sufficient food and water

The owner of pig must ensure that the pig has sufficient food and water.
Penalty: Fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

6 Owner of pig found wandering to recapture pig

If the owner of land –
(a) Finds a pig at large on that land; and
(b) Requests the owner of the pig to remove it,
the owner of the pig must comply with that request as soon as
reasonably practicable but in any event within 24 hours of being
requested to do so.
Penalty: (a) Fine not exceeding 2 penalty units;
(b) If a person is convicted of an offence under this section
within one year after being convicted of an offence under
this section – 5 penalty units.

7 Owner of land may capture and destroy pig wandering on land

(1) If the owner of land finds a pig wandering at large on that land the
owner may –
(a) Destroy the pig; or
(b) Claim ownership of the pig,
and for either of those purposes may capture the pig.
(2) If the owner of land destroys a pig under subsection (1)(a) the carcass
of the pig is the property of that owner.
(3) If the owner of land captures and claims ownership of a pig under
subsection (1)(b) the pig becomes the property of that owner.
(4) Subsections (2) and (3) apply despite the fact that –
(a) The pig was the property of some other person before its destruction
or capture; and
(b) The owner of the land may have been aware that the pig was the
property of some other person before its destruction or capture.

8 Constable may be requested to capture wandering pig

(1) If the owner of land finds a pig wandering at large on that land the
owner may request a constable to –
(a) Destroy the pig; or
(b) Capture and remove the pig.
(2) A constable may comply with a request made under subsection (1).
(3) If a constable destroys or captures a pig in accordance with a request
made under subsection (1) the carcass of the pig or, if captured live, the pig must
be disposed of in a manner determined by the Chief of Police.
(4) The Chief of Police may determine that the carcass of the pig or the pig

Pig Control Act 1998

1413
is to be returned to the owner of the pig but is under no obligation to do so.
(5) Subsections (1) and (2) apply although before its destruction or capture –
(a) The pig was the property of some other person; and
(b) The owner of the land or the constable or both may have been aware
of that fact.

9 Constable may destroy or capture pig found wandering at large

(1) A constable may –
(a) Destroy; or
(b) Capture,
a pig found wandering at large and for either of those purposes may enter land.
(2) If a constable destroys or captures a pig under subsection (1) the carcass
of the pig or, if captured live, the pig must be disposed of in a manner determined
by the Chief of Police.
(3) The Chief of Police may determine that the carcass of the pig or the pig
is to be returned to the owner of the pig but is under no obligation to do so.
(4) Subsection (1) applies although before its destruction or capture –
(a) The pig was the property of some other person; and
(b) The constable may have been aware of that fact.

10 Constable may destroy a pig suffering from injury

(1) A constable –
(a) May destroy a pig that is apparently suffering from injury, disease
or neglect; and
(b) For that purpose, may enter the land.
(2) If a constable destroys a pig under subsection (1) the carcass of the pig
must be disposed of in a manner determined by the Chief of Police.
(3) The Chief of Police may determine that the carcass of the pig is to be
returned to the owner of the pig but is under no obligation to do so.
(4) Subsection (1) applies although before its destruction –
(a) The pig was the property of some other person; and
(b) The constable may have been aware of that fact.

11 Power of entry

If a constable has good cause to suspect that an offence against this Act is
being committed on land the constable may enter the land –
(a) To inspect –
(i) any pig for the time being appearing to be kept on that land; or
(ii) the conditions in which any such pig is being kept; and
(b) If authorised to do so under any other provision of this Act, destroy
a pig on the land.

12 Power of constable to request information

(1) A constable may for the purposes of this Act request –
(a) A person appearing to be in charge of a pig; or
(b) A person appearing to be the occupier of land on which a pig is for
the time being kept,
to state the person’s name and address; and if that person claims not to be the
owner of the pig, the name and address of the owner of the pig.
(2) A person must not –
(a) Without reasonable excuse, fail or refuse to comply with a lawful
request under subsection (1); or
1414 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) Wilfully state a false name or address in response to such a request.
Penalty: Fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(3) A constable may arrest without warrant a person who –
(a) Fails or refuses to comply with a lawful request under subsection
(1); or
(b) In the opinion of the constable, has stated a false name or address
in response to such a request.

13 Wilful obstruction of constable

(1) A person must not wilfully obstruct or hinder a constable in the exercise
of the constable’s powers under this Act.
Penalty: Fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(2) A constable may arrest without warrant a person who wilfully obstructs
or hinders the constable in the exercise of the constable’s powers under this Act.

14 Court may order convicted person to pay compensation

(1) If the Court –
(a) Has convicted a person of an offence under this Act in respect of a
pig wandering at large on the land of another person; and
(b) Is satisfied that the pig caused damage on the land of that other
person, the Court may –
inquire into the extent of that damage; and in addition to any other penalty it
imposes in respect of the offence or in substitution for any such penalty order the
person convicted of the offence to pay to the owner of the land such amount as
the Court considers is fair compensation for the damage caused by the pig.
(2) If the Court orders a person to pay compensation under subsection (1)
the making of that order does not prohibit any person taking action for the recovery
of damages or additional damages.

15 Owner liable for damage done by a pig wandering at large

The owner of a pig that wanders at large is liable in damages for damage
done by the pig while wandering at large, and it is not necessary for a person
seeking damages to show –
(a) A previous propensity in the pig to wander at large; or
(b) The owner ’s knowledge of any such propensity; or
(c) That the damage was attributable to neglect on the part of the owner
of the pig.

16 Indemnity

(1) Action, civil or criminal, does not lie against the Government, the Chief
of Police, a constable or any other person in respect of –
(a) The destruction or capture of a pig or the disposal of a pig or the
carcass of a pig under this Act; or
(b) The attempted destruction or capture of a pig under this Act if the
pig is wounded or maimed instead of being so destroyed or
captured.
(2) Subsection (1)(b) does not apply if unnecessary suffering is caused to a
pig.

17 Compensation not payable for destruction of pig

The owner of a pig has no right to compensation in respect of a pig destroyed
or captured or disposed of under this Act.

Pig Control Act 1998

1415

18 Regulations

(1) Cabinet may make regulations necessary or convenient for the purposes
of this Act.
(2) Regulations made under subsection (1) may, in particular –
(a) Provide for the registration of pigs;
(b) Provide for the imposition of fees for the registration of pigs;
(c) Provide for pigs to be distinguishable as the property of an
ascertainable person by the wearing of tags or collars, or by branding
or earmarks, or by any similar means;
(d) Provide for the registration of the owners of pigs;
(e) Provide for the imposition of fees for the registration of owners of
pigs;
(f) Prescribe the manner in which enclosures for pigs are to be
constructed;
(g) Prohibit or regulate where the enclosures for pigs may be placed;
(h) Provide for the imposition of fines not exceeding 5 penalty units
for a failure to comply with any provision of the regulations; and
(i) Provide for the remission of fees in whole or in part in cases of
hardship.
(3) The Cabinet may exempt a person from compliance with any provision
of a regulation made under this section if the Cabinet is satisfied that compliance
with the regulation would cause the person undue hardship.
(4) An exemption given under subsection (3) may be given subject to
conditions and is of no effect unless those conditions are complied with.

1416 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1417

PRICE CONTROL ON IMPORTED GOODS FOR RESALE IN NIUE ACT 1975

1975/5 – 13 February 1975

1

Short title

8

Keeping of records

2

Interpretation

9

Penalties

3

Administration

10

Vicarious responsibility

4

Price Control Board

11

Regulations

5

Delegation of powers

12

[Spent]

6

Price orders

7

Obtaining information

To consolidate and amend the law relating to the control of prices on imported goods for resale in Niue

1 Short title

This is the Price Control on Imported Goods for Resale in Niue Act 1975.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Board” means the Price Control Board;
“goods” shall include merchandise, articles, things and commodities, but
shall not include any liquor within the meaning of the Liquor Act 1975;
“Minister” means the Minister of Customs Shipping and Trade;
“price” when used in connection with the sale of any goods or the
performance of any services, includes every valuable consideration
whatsoever, whether direct or indirect;
“retail price” means the price paid or payable for goods sold on retail to a
consumer;
“service” includes any service supplied for hire or reward by any person
engaged in trade or business;
“trader” means any person who in connection with business carried on by
him, sells or proposes to sell any goods, or who supplies or carries on
any service;
“wholesale” means the sale or supply of goods to a person for the purpose
of resale or for use by such person in his trade or business.

3 Administration

(1) There is hereby constituted a Price Control section of the Customs
Department, which shall be under the immediate control of an officer of the Public
Service called the Price Control Officer.
(2) The office of the Price Control Officer may be held in conjunction with
any other office which the Public Service Commission shall consider to be not
incompatible with it.
(3) This Act shall be administered by the Price Control section under the
control of the Minister.
1418 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

4 Price Control Board

(1) For the purpose of this Act there is hereby established a Board to be
known as the Price Control Board, consisting of –
(a) A Chairman, and
(b) Not less than 2, nor more than 4 other persons,
to be appointed by Cabinet.
(2) Every member of the Board shall hold office for 3 years, but may sooner
resign by notice in writing to the Minister, or be removed by Cabinet for disability,
misconduct, or neglect of duty proved to the satisfaction of Cabinet.
(3) Of the members appointed under subsection (1)(b), one shall be a person
whom Cabinet considers representative of merchants and traders carrying on
business in Niue, and one shall be a person whom Cabinet considers representative
of consumers in Niue.

5 Delegation of powers

(1) With the written consent of the Minister, the Board may delegate to the
Price Control Officer all or any of the powers exercisable by it under this Act,
including the powers to make price orders and to institute proceedings.
(2) Any person affected by any order of the Price Control Officer acting
pursuant to a delegation under this section may at any time appeal therefrom to
the Board by giving to the Minister a written notice of appeal.
(3) The Board may determine any appeal under this section in such manner
as it thinks fit.

6 Price orders

(1) If the Board considers it expedient in the public interest to control the
price of any goods or services, it may make price orders fixing the maximum or
minimum or actual price of such goods or services, either generally throughout
Niue or in any specified part of or place in Niue.
(2) Any price order may relate to the sale of goods either at wholesale or
retail prices.
(3) Any price order may contain such incidental and supplementary
provisions as are necessary or expedient.
(4) (a) The Board may at any time revoke or amend any price order.
(b) The Board shall not increase the price of any goods as fixed by any
price order, more than once in any 3 month period.
(5) The decision of the Board shall be final and shall not be subject to any
right of appeal.
(6) Every price order shall be published in the Niuean and English
languages in one or more newspapers or published in such other manner as the
Board shall consider sufficient, and no price order shall come into force before it
has been so published.
(7) It shall be the duty of every trader whose business includes the sale of
any goods or the performance of any services to which a current price order made
under this Act applies, to keep displayed in a prominent position on the premises
in which the sale of such goods or the performance of such services are offered, a
list showing clearly for the information of the public the price fixed in respect of
such goods or services.
(8) The Price Control Officer may cause lists to be printed in the Niuean or
English language or both and may require the trader to exhibit the same in the
manner aforesaid.

Price Control on Imported Goods Act 1975 1419

(9) The Price Control Officer may with regard to any specified goods require that any retailer having such goods for sale shall cause the same to be legibly and conspicuously marked with the selling price for the information of the public.
(10) Nothing in this section shall be construed to affect the exercise by any person or authority having statutory powers to fix prices, fares or charges under any other enactment.

7 Obtaining information

(1) For the purposes of this Act, any member of the Board, or the Price
Control Officer, or any other officer lawfully delegated by the Board may –
(a) Require any trader to supply him either orally or in writing with
any information in his possession relating to goods or services;
(b) By notice published in a newspaper to require any traders or
specified class of traders to render returns setting forth such
particulars regarding the sale or performance of services as may be
specified in the notice;
(c) Require any trader to produce for inspection any records, accounts,
or documents relating to the sale of goods or supply of services,
and to furnish copies of them;
(d) During business hours, to inspect all books of account and records
of any trader, and to make copies or extracts;
(e) Take possession of any documents or papers which appear to him
to constitute prima facie evidence of breach of a price order.
(2) No person shall –
(a) Obstruct any officer or person in the lawful exercise of his powers
under this section;
(b) Wilfully fail to give any information or to produce any record,
account or document lawfully required of him under this section;
(c) Knowingly give any false information relating to goods and services
to any such person.

8 Keeping of records

Every trader shall keep such records and accounts, including stock and
costing records, as are customary and proper in the type of business carried on by
him and shall retain such records and accounts for a period of 5 years after they
come into being.

9 Penalties

(1) Any person who sells or offers for sale any goods or services in breach
of any relevant price order, or fails to comply with this Act or any order, notice,
direction or requirement lawfully made or published thereunder shall be guilty
of an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty
units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or to both.
(2) Where a company is charged with an offence under this Act, every
person who at the time of the commission of the offence was a director or officer
of the company may be charged jointly in the same proceedings with such
company, and where the company is convicted of the offence, every such director
or officer shall be deemed to be guilty of that offence unless he satisfies the Court
that the offence was committed without his knowledge and that he exercised all
due diligence to prevent the commission of the offence.
(3) Proceedings against a director of a company under subsection (2) shall
not be instituted except on the direction of the Board.
1420 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

10 Vicarious responsibility

Any trader who engages any employee shall be answerable for the acts or
omissions of his employee in so far as they concern the business of such trader,
and if such employee commits any act or makes any omission which is an offence
or would be an offence if made or committed by such employer, then and in such
case both the employer and the employee or either of them may be charged with
such offence.

11 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as it thinks fit for the purposes of this
Act.

12 [Spent]

1421

PROCEEDS OF CRIME ACT 1998

1998/245 – 16 December 1998

24 Court may lift corporate veil

25 Enforcement of confiscation orders

26 Amounts paid in respect of registered

foreign confiscation orders

FORFEITURE ORDERS, CONFISCATION ORDERS AND

RELATED MATTERS

General

6 Application for forfeiture order or

confiscation order on conviction

7 Notice of application

8 Amendment of application

9 Procedure on application

10 Application for forfeiture order where

person has absconded

Forfeiture Orders

11 Forfeiture order on conviction

12 Effect of forfeiture order

13 Protection of third parties

14 Discharge of forfeiture order on appeal and

quashing of conviction

15 Payment instead of forfeiture order

16 Enforcement of order for payment instead

of forfeiture

17 Forfeiture order where person has

absconded

18 Registered foreign forfeiture orders

Confiscation Orders

19 Confiscation order on conviction

20 Rules for determining and assessing value

21 Statements relating to benefits from

commission of serious offences

22 Amount to be recovered under confiscation

order

23 Variations of confiscation orders

PART 3

PROVISION FOR FACILITATING POLICE INVESTIGATIONS

AND PRESERVING PROPERTY LIABLE TO FORFEITURE

AND CONFISCATION ORDERS

Powers of Search and Seizure

27 Warrant to search land for tainted property

28 Police may seize other tainted property

29 Return of property seized

30 Search for and seizure of tainted property

in relation to foreign offences

Restraining Orders

31 Application for restraining order

32 Restraining order

33 Undertakings by the Crown

34 Notice of application for restraining order

35 Service of restraining order

36 Further orders

37 Financial Secretary to satisfy confiscation

order

38 Registration of restraining order

39 Contravention of restraining orders

40 Court may revoke restraining orders

41 When restraining order ceases to be in force

42 Interim restraining order may be made in

respect of foreign offence

43 Registered foreign restraining orders –

general

44 Registered foreign restraining orders –

Court may direct Financial Secretary to take

custody and control of property

45 Registered foreign restraining orders –

undertakings

46 Registered foreign restraining orders – time

when order ceases to be in force

1422 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Disclosure of Information Held by Government

Departments

61 Direction to disclose information

62 Further disclosure of information and

documents

63 Evidential value of copies

PART 4

OFFENCES

64 Money laundering

65 Possession of property suspected of being

proceeds of crime

66 Conduct by directors, servants or agents

PART 5

MISCELLANEOUS

67 Standard of proof

68 Costs

69 Non-liability of Financial Secretary

70 Operation of other laws not affected

71 Regulations

To provide for confiscation of the proceeds of crime, and for related purposes

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Proceeds of Crime Act 1998.

2 [Spent]

3 Principal objects

The principal objects of this Act are –
(a) To deprive persons of the proceeds of, and benefits derived from,
the commission of serious offences;
(b) To provide for the forfeiture of property used in, in connection with,
or for the purpose of facilitating the commission of serious offences;
(c) To enable law enforcement authorities to trace such proceeds,
benefits and property; and
(d) To make it an offence to engage in money laundering.

4 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Attorney-General” means the chief legal adviser to the Government of
Niue;
“benefit” has the same meaning as in section 5(1);
“Commissioner” means a Commissioner of the Court;
“confiscation order” means an order made by the Court under section 19(1);

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1423
“document”, in relation to an offence, means a written or printed thing and includes –
(a) a map, plan, graph or drawing; (b) a photograph;
(c) a disk, tape, sound track or other device in which sound or other data (not being visual images) are embodied so as to be capable (with or without the aid of some other equipment) of being reproduced from it; and
(d) a film, negative, tape or other device in which one or more visual
images are embodied, so as to be capable (as aforesaid) of being
reproduced from it;
“foreign confiscation order” means an order made under the law of a foreign
country for a person to pay to the foreign country an amount
representing the value (or part of it) of the person’s benefits from an
offence against the law of that country;
“foreign forfeiture order” means an order, made under the law of a foreign
country, for the forfeiture of property in respect of an offence against
the law of that country;
“foreign restraining order” means an order, made under the law of a foreign
country, restraining a particular person, or all persons, from dealing
with property, being an order made in respect of an offence against the
law of that country;
“foreign serious offence” means a serious offence against the law of a foreign
country;
“forfeiture order” means an order made by the Court under section 11(1);
“gift caught by this Act”is to be construed in accordance with section 5(12)
and (14);
“interest”, in relation to property, means –
(a) a legal or equitable estate or interest in the property; or
(b) a right, power or privilege in connection with the property;
“Judge” includes a Commissioner;
“proceeds” in relation to an offence, means any property that is derived or
realised, directly or indirectly, by any person from the commission of
the offence;
“proceeds of crime” means –
(a) proceeds of a serious offence; or
(b) any property that is derived or realised, directly or indirectly, by
any person from acts or omissions that occurred outside Niue and
would, if they had occurred in Niue, have constituted a serious
offence;
“production order” means an order made by the Court under section 47;
“property” includes money and all other property, real or personal,
including things in action and other intangible or incorporeal property;
“property-tracking document”, in relation to an offence, means –
(a) a document relevant to –
(i) identifying, locating, or quantifying property of a person who
committed the offence; or
(ii) identifying or locating any document necessary for the transfer
of property of a person who committed the offence; or
1424

5

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(b) a document relevant to –
(i) identifying, locating or quantifying tainted property in relation
to the offence; or
(ii) identifying or locating any document necessary for the transfer
of tainted property in relation to the offence;
“realisable property” has the same meaning as in section 5;
“relevant application period”, in relation to a person’s conviction of a serious
offence, means the period of 12 months after –
(a) where the person is to be taken to have been convicted of the offence
by reason of section 5(2)(a) – the day on which the person was
convicted of the offence;
(b) where the person is to be taken to have been convicted of the offence
by reason of section 5(2)(b) – the day on which the person was
discharged without conviction; or
(c) where the person is to be taken to have been convicted of the offence
by reason of section 5(2)(c) – the day on which the court took the
offence into account in passing sentence for the other offence
referred to in that section;
“relevant offence”, in relation to tainted property, means an offence by
reason of the commission of which the property is tainted property;
“restraining order” means an order made by the Court under section 32(1);
“serious offence” means an offence the maximum penalty for which is death,
or imprisonment for not less than 12 months;
“tainted property”, in relation to a serious offence, means –
(a) property used in, or in connection with, the commission of the
offence; or
(b) proceeds of the offence;
and when used without reference to a particular offence means tainted
property in relation to a serious offence;
“unlawful activity” means an act or omission that constitutes an offence
against a law in force in Niue or a foreign country.

Definition of certain terms

(1) In this Act –
(a) “A benefit” includes any property, service or advantage, whether
direct or indirect;
(b) “To benefit” has a corresponding meaning;
(c) A reference to a benefit derived or obtained by, or otherwise accruing
to, a person (A) includes a reference to a benefit derived or obtained
by, or otherwise accruing to, another person at A’s request or
direction.
(2) For the purposes of this Act, a person is taken to be convicted of a
serious offence if –
(a) The person is convicted, whether summarily or on indictment, of
the offence;
(b) The person is charged with, and found guilty of, the offence but is
discharged without conviction; or
(c) A court, with the consent of the person, takes the offence, of which
the person has not been found guilty, into account in passing
sentence on the person for another offence.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1425
(3) In this Act, “realisable property” means, subject to section 6 –
(a) Any property held by a person who has been convicted of, or
charged with, a serious offence; and
(b) Any property held by a person to whom a person so convicted or
charged has directly or indirectly made a gift caught by this Act.
(4) Property is not realisable property if –
(a) There is in force, in respect of that property, a forfeiture order under
this Act or under another enactment; or
(b) A forfeiture order is proposed to be made against that property
under this Act or another enactment.
(5) For the purposes of sections 21 and 22 the amount that might be realised
at the time a confiscation order is made against a person is the total of the values
at that time of all the realisable property held by the person less the total amounts
payable under an obligation, where there is an obligation having priority at that
time, together with the total of the values at that time of all gifts caught by this
Act.
(6) For the purposes of subsection (5), an obligation has priority at any time if it is an obligation of the person to –
(a) Pay an amount due in respect of a fine, or other order of a court, imposed or made on conviction of an offence, where the fine was imposed or the order was made before the confiscation order; or
(b) Pay an amount due in respect of any tax, rate, duty, excise or other impost payable under an enactment for the time being in force;
(c) Pay any other civil obligation as may be determined by the Court.
(7) Subject to subsections (8) and (9), for the purposes of this Act, the value
of property (other than cash), in relation to a person holding the property, is –
(a) Where any other person holds an interest in the property – the
market value of the first-mentioned person’s beneficial interest in
the property, less the amount required to discharge any
encumbrance on that interest; and
(b) In any other case – its market value.
(8) References in this Act to the value at any time (referred to in subsection
(9) as “the material time”) of the transfer of any property are references to whichever
is the greater of –
(a) The value of the property to the recipient when he or she receives
it, adjusted to take account of subsequent changes in the value of
money; or
(b) Where subsection (9) applies – the value there mentioned,
whichever is the greater.
(9) Where at the material time the recipient holds –
(a) The property which he or she received (not being cash); or
(b) Property which, in whole or in part, directly or indirectly represents
in the recipient’s hands the property which he or she received –
the value referred to in subsection (7)(b) is the value to the recipient at the material
time of the property referred to in paragraph (a) or, as the case may be, of the
property mentioned in paragraph (b), so far as it represents the property which he
or she received.
(10) Subject to subsection (14), a reference to the value at any time (referred
to in subsection (11) as “the material time”) of a gift is a reference to –
(a) The value of the gift to the recipient when he or she received it,
adjusted to take account of subsequent changes in the value of
money; or
1426 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) Where subsection (11) applies – the value there mentioned, whichever is the greater.
(11) Subject to subsection (14), where at the material time a person holds – (a) The property which the person received, not being cash; or
(b) Property which, in whole or in part, directly or indirectly represents in the person’s hands the property which the person received,
the value referred to in subsection (10)(b) is the value to the person at the material time of the property mentioned in paragraph (a) or the value of the property mentioned in paragraph (b) so far as it so represents the property which the person received.
(12) A gift, including a gift made before the commencement of this Act, is caught by this Act where –
(a) It was made by the person convicted or charged at a time after the commission of the offence or, if more than one, the earliest of the offences to which the proceedings for the time being relate, and the Court considers it appropriate in all the circumstances to take the gift into account;
(b) It was made by the person convicted or charged at any time and
was a gift of property –
(i) Received by the person in connection with the commission of
a serious offence committed by the person or by another person;
or
(ii) Which in whole or in part directly or indirectly represented in
the person’s hands property received by the person in that
connection.
(13) The reference in subsection (12) to “an offence to which the
proceedings for the time being relate” includes, where the proceedings have
resulted in the conviction of the person, a reference to any offence that the Court
takes into consideration when determining sentence.
(14) For the purposes of this Act –
(a) The circumstances in which a person must be treated as making a
gift include those where the person transfers property to another
person directly or indirectly for a consideration the value of which
is significantly less than the value of the consideration provided or
the property transferred by the person; and
(b) In those circumstances, subsections (10), (11) and (12) shall apply
as if the person had made a gift of such share in the property as
bears to the whole property the same proportion as the difference
between the values referred to in paragraph (a) bears to the value
of the consideration provided or the property transferred by the
person.
PART 2
FORFEITURE ORDERS, CONFISCATION ORDERS AND RELATED MATTERS

General

6 Application for forfeiture order or confiscation order on conviction

(1) Subject to subsection (2), where a person is convicted of a serious offence
committed after the coming into force of this Act, the Attorney-General may apply to the Court for one or both of the following orders –
(a) A forfeiture order against property that is tainted property in respect
of the offence;

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1427
(b) A confiscation order against the person in respect of benefits derived by the person from the commission of the offence.
(2) The Attorney-General may not make an application after the end of the relevant application period in relation to the conviction.
(3) An application under this section may be made in respect of one or more than one serious offence.
(4) Where an application under this section is finally determined, no further application for a forfeiture order or a confiscation order may be made in respect of the offence for which the person was convicted unless the Court gives leave for the making of a new application on being satisfied –
(a) That the property or benefit to which the new application relates was identified after the previous application was determined; or
(b) That necessary evidence became available only after the previous application was determined; or
(c) That it is in the interests of justice that the new application be made.

7 Notice of application

(1) Where the Attorney-General applies for a forfeiture order against
property in respect of a person’s conviction of an offence –
(a) The Attorney-General must give written notice of the application
to the person and to any other person who the Attorney-General
has reason to believe may have an interest in the property;
(b) The person, and any other person who claims an interest in the
property, may appear and adduce evidence at the hearing of the
application; and
(c) The Court may, at any time before the final determination of the
application, direct the Attorney-General –
(i) to give notice of the application to any person who, in the
opinion of the Court, appears to have an interest in the property;
or
(ii) to publish in a newspaper published and circulating in Niue
notice of the application, in the manner and containing such
particulars and within the time that the Court considers
appropriate.
(2) Where the Attorney-General applies for a confiscation order against a
person –
(a) The Attorney-General must give the person written notice of the application; and
(b) The person may appear and adduce evidence at the hearing of the application.

8 Amendment of application

(1) The Court hearing an application under section 6(1) may, before final
determination of the application, and on the application of the Attorney-General
amend the application to include any other property or benefit, as the case may
be, upon being satisfied that –
(a) The property or benefit was not reasonably capable of identification
when the application was originally made; or
(b) Necessary evidence became available only after the application was
originally made.
(2) Where the Attorney-General applies to amend an application for a
forfeiture order and the amendment would have the effect of including additional
1428 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
property in the application for the forfeiture order the Attorney-General must give written notice of the application to amend to any person who the Attorney- General has reason to believe may have an interest in property to be included in the application for the forfeiture order.
(3) Any person who claims an interest in the property to be included in the application for the forfeiture order may appear and adduce evidence at the hearing of the application to amend.
(4) Where the Attorney-General applies to amend an application for a confiscation order against a person and the effect of the amendment would be to include an additional benefit in the application for the confiscation order the Attorney-General must give the person written notice of the application to amend.

9 Procedure on application

(1) Where an application is made to the Court for a forfeiture order or a
confiscation order in respect of a person’s conviction of an offence, the Court may,
in determining the application, have regard to the transcript of any proceedings
against the person for the offence.
(2) Where an application is made for a forfeiture order or a confiscation
order to the Court before which the person was convicted, and the Court has not,
when the application is made, passed sentence on the person for the offence, the
Court may, if it is satisfied that it is reasonable to do so in all the circumstances,
defer passing sentence until it has determined the application for the order.

10 Application for forfeiture order where person has absconded

(1) Where a person absconds in connection with a serious offence
committed, the Attorney-General may, within the period of 6 months after the
person so absconds, apply to the Court for a forfeiture order under section 17 in
respect of any tainted property.
(2) For the purposes of this section, a person shall be deemed to have
absconded in connection with an offence if –
(a) An information has been laid alleging the commission of the offence
by the person;
(b) A warrant for the arrest of the person is issued in relation to that
information; and
(c) Reasonable attempts to arrest the person pursuant to the warrant
have been unsuccessful during the period of 6 months commencing
on the day the warrant was issued,
and the person shall be deemed to have so absconded on the last day of that
period of 6 months.
(3) Where the Attorney-General applies under this section for a forfeiture
order against any tainted property the Court shall, before hearing the application –
(a) Require notice of the application to be given to any person who, in
the opinion of the Court, appears to have an interest in the property;
or
(b) Direct notice of the application to be published in a newspaper
published and circulating in Niue containing such particulars and
for so long as the Court may require.

Forfeiture Orders

11 Forfeiture order on conviction

(1) Where the Attorney-General applies to the Court for an order under
this section against property in respect of a person’s conviction of an offence and

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1429
the Court is satisfied that the property is tainted property in respect of the offence, the Court may order that the property, or such of the property as is specified by the Court in the order, be forfeited to the Crown.
(2) In determining whether property is tainted property the Court may
infer –
(a) Where the evidence establishes that the property was in the person’s possession at the time of, or immediately after, the commission of the offence of which the person was convicted – that the property was used in, or in connection with, the commission of the offence;
(b) Where the evidence establishes that property, and in particular money, was found in the person’s possession or under the person’s control in a building, vehicle, receptacle or place during the course of investigations conducted by the police before or after the arrest and charge of the person for the offence of which the person was convicted – that the property was derived, obtained or realised as a result of the commission by the person of the offence of which the person was convicted;
(c) Where the evidence establishes that the value, after the commission
of the offence, of all ascertainable property of a person convicted of
the offence exceeds the value of all ascertainable property of that
person prior to the commission of that offence, and the Court is
satisfied that the income of that person from sources unrelated to
criminal activity of that person cannot reasonably account for the
increase in value – that the value of the increase represents property
which was derived, obtained or realised by the person directly or
indirectly from the commission of the offence of which the person
was convicted.
(3) Where the Court orders that property, other than money, be forfeited
to the Crown, the Court shall specify in the order the amount that it considers to be the value of the property at the time when the order is made.
(4) In considering whether a forfeiture order should be made under subsection (1), the Court may have regard to –
(a) The rights and interests, if any, of third parties in the property; (b) The gravity of the offence concerned;
(c) Any hardship that may reasonably be expected to be caused to any
person by the operation of the order; and
(d) The use that is ordinarily made of the property, or the use to which
the property was intended to be put.
(5) Where the Court makes a forfeiture order, the Court may give such
directions as are necessary or convenient for giving effect to the order.

12 Effect of forfeiture order

(1) Subject to subsection (2), where the Court makes a forfeiture order
against property, the property vests absolutely in the Crown by virtue of the order. (2) Where a forfeiture order is made against registrable property –
(a) The property vests in the Crown in equity but does not vest in the Crown at law until the applicable registration requirements have been complied with;
(b) The Crown is entitled to be registered as owner of the property;
and
(c) The Attorney-General has power on behalf of the Crown to do, or
authorise the doing of, anything necessary or convenient to obtain
1430

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

the registration of the Crown as owner, including the execution of any instrument required to be executed by a person transferring an interest in property of that kind.
(3) If a forfeiture order has been made against registrable property –
(a) The Attorney-General has the power on behalf of the Crown to do
anything necessary or convenient to give notice of, or otherwise
protect, the equitable interest of the Crown in the property; and
(b) Any such action by or on behalf of the Crown is not a dealing for
the purposes of subsection (4)(a).
(4) Where the Court makes a forfeiture order against property –
(a) The property shall not, except with the leave of the Court and under
any directions of the Court, be disposed of, or otherwise dealt with,
by or on behalf of the Crown, before the relevant appeal date; and
(b) If, after the relevant appeal date, the order has not been discharged,
the property may be disposed of, and the proceeds applied or
otherwise dealt with in accordance with the direction of the
Attorney-General.
(5) Without limiting the generality of subsection (4)(b), the directions that
may be given under that paragraph include a direction that property is to be
disposed of under the provisions of an enactment specified in the direction.
(6) In this section –
“registrable property” means property the title to which is passed by
registration on a register kept under any law of Niue;
“relevant appeal date”, used in relation to a forfeiture order made in
consequence of a person’s conviction of a serious offence, means –
(a) The date on which the period allowed by the rules of court for the
lodging of an appeal against a person’s conviction, or for the lodging
of an appeal against the making of a forfeiture order, expires without
an appeal having been lodged, whichever is the later; or
(b) Where an appeal against a person’s conviction or against the making
of a forfeiture order is lodged – the date on which the appeal, or the
later appeal, lapses in accordance with the rules of court or is finally
determined.

13 Protection of third parties

(1) Where an application is made for a forfeiture order against property, a
person who claims an interest in the property may apply to the Court, before the forfeiture order is made, for an order under subsection (2).
(2) If a person applies to the Court for an order under this subsection in respect of the person’s interest in property and the Court is satisfied –
(a) That the applicant was not in any way involved in the commission
of an offence in respect of which forfeiture of the property is sought,
or the forfeiture order against the property was made; and
(b) If the applicant acquired the interest during or after the commission
of the offence – that the applicant acquired the interest –
(i) for sufficient consideration; and
(ii) without knowing, and in circumstances such as not to arouse a
reasonable suspicion, that the property was, at the time of the
acquisition, tainted property,
the Court shall make an order declaring the nature, extent and value (as at the
time when the order is made) of the applicant’s interest.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1431
(3) Subject to subsection (4), where a forfeiture order has already been made directing the forfeiture of property, a person who claims an interest in the property may, before the end of the period of 6 months commencing on the day on which the forfeiture order is made, apply under this subsection to the Court for an order under subsection (2).
(4) A person who –
(a) Had knowledge of the application for the forfeiture order before
the order was made; or
(b) appeared at the hearing of that application,
shall not be permitted to make an application under subsection (3), except with
the leave of the Court.
(5) A person who makes an application under subsection (1) or (3) must
give written notice of the making of the application to the Attorney-General, who
shall be a party of any proceedings in the application.
(6) An applicant or the Attorney-General may, under the rules of court,
appeal to the Court of Appeal from an order made under subsection (2).
(7) The Cabinet shall, on application by any person who has obtained an
order under subsection (2), and where the period allowed by the rules of court
with respect to the making of appeals has expired and any appeal from that order
taken under subsection (6) has been determined –
(a) Direct that the property, or the part of it to which the interest of the
applicant relates, be returned to the applicant; or
(b) Direct that an amount equal to the value of the interest of the
applicant, as declared in the order, be paid to the applicant.

14 Discharge of forfeiture order on appeal and quashing of conviction

(1) Where the Court makes a forfeiture order against property in reliance
on a person’s conviction of an offence and the conviction is subsequently quashed, the quashing of the conviction discharges the order.
(2) Where a forfeiture order against property is discharged as provided by subsection (1) or by the Court hearing an appeal against the making of the order, any person who claims to have had an interest in the property immediately before the making of the forfeiture order may apply to the Premier, in writing, for the transfer of the interest to the person.
(3) On receipt of an application under subsection (2) from a person who
had such an interest in the property, the Cabinet shall –
(a) If the interest is vested in the Crown – give directions that the
property or part of it to which the interest of the applicant relates
be transferred to the person; or
(b) In any other case – direct that there be payable to the person an
amount equal to the value of the interest as at the time the order is
made.
(4) In the exercise of powers under this section and section 13, the Attorney-
General shall have the power to do, or authorise the doing of, anything necessary
or convenient to effect the transfer or return of property, including the execution
of any instrument and the making of an application for the registration of an interest
in the property on any appropriate register.
1432 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

15 Payment instead of forfeiture order

Where the Court is satisfied that a forfeiture order should be made in respect
of property of a person under section 11 or section 17 but that the property or any
part of it or interest in it cannot be made subject to such an order and, in particular

(a) Cannot, on the exercise of due diligence, be located;
(b) Has been transferred to a third party in circumstances that do not
give rise to a reasonable inference that the title or interest was
transferred for the purpose of avoiding the forfeiture of the property;
(c) Is located outside Niue; or
(d) Has been commingled with other property that cannot be divided
without difficulty;
the Court may, instead of ordering the property or part of it or interest in it to be
forfeited, order the person to pay to the Crown an amount equal to the value of
the property, part or interest.

16 Enforcement of order for payment instead of forfeiture

(1) An amount payable by a person to the Crown under an order under
section 15 is a civil debt due by the person to the Crown.
(2) An order against a person under section 15 may be enforced as if it
were an order made in civil proceedings instituted by the Crown against the person
to recover a debt due by the person to the Crown and the debt arising from the
order shall be taken to be a judgment debt.

17 Forfeiture order where person has absconded

(1) Subject to section 10(3), where an application is made to the Court under
section 10(1) for a forfeiture order against any tainted property because a person
has absconded in connection with a serious offence and the Court is satisfied that –
(a) Any property is tainted property in respect of the offence;
(b) Proceedings in respect of a serious offence committed in relation to
that property were commenced; and
(c) The accused charged with the offence referred to in paragraph (b)
has absconded;
the Court may order that the property, or such of the property as is specified by
the Court in the order, be forfeited to the Crown.
(2) Sections 11(2), (3), (4) and (5), 12 and 13 shall apply with such
modifications as are necessary to give effect to this section.

18 Registered foreign forfeiture orders

If a foreign forfeiture order is registered in the Court under the Mutual
Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998 sections 11 to 18 apply in relation to the
order as if –
(a) All references to an appeal against the making of an order and to
the relevant appeal date were omitted; and
(b) A period of 6 weeks were substituted for the period of 6 months
provided in section 13(3).

Confiscation Orders

19 Confiscation order on conviction

(1) Subject to this section, where the Attorney-General applies to the Court
for a confiscation order against a person in respect of that person’s conviction of a
serious offence, the Court may, if it is satisfied that the person has benefited from

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1433
that offence, order the person to pay to the Crown an amount equal to the value of the person’s benefits from the offence or such lesser amount as the Court certifies under section 23 to be the amount that might be realised at the time the confiscation order is made.
(2) The Court shall assess the value of the benefits derived by a person from the commission of an offence under sections 20 to 23.
(3) The Court shall not make a confiscation order under this section –
(a) Until the period allowed by the rules of court for the lodging of an
appeal against conviction has expired without such an appeal
having been lodged; or
(b) Where an appeal against conviction has been lodged, until the
appeal lapses under the rules of court or is finally determined.

20 Rules for determining benefit and assessing value

(1) Where a person obtains property as the result of, or in connection with
the commission of, a serious offence, the person’s benefit is the value of the property so obtained.
(2) Where a person derives an advantage as the result of, or in connection
with the commission of, a serious offence, the person’s advantage shall be deemed
to be a sum of money equal to the value of the advantage so derived.
(3) The Court, in determining whether a person has benefited from the
commission of a serious offence or from that offence taken together with other
serious offences and, if so, in assessing the value of the benefit, shall, unless the
contrary is proved, deem –
(a) All property –
(i) appearing to the Court to be held by the person on the day on
which the application is made; and
(ii) appearing to the Court to be held by the person at any time –
(A) within the period between the day the offence, or the earliest
offence, was committed and the day on which the
application is made; or
(B) within the period of 5 years immediately before the day on
which the application is made,
being whichever is the shorter period,
to be property that came into the possession or under the control of
the person by reason of the commission of that offence or those
offences;
(b) Any expenditure by the person since the beginning of that period
to be expenditure met out of payments received by the person as a
result of, or in connection with, the commission of that offence or
those offences; and
(c) Any property received or deemed to have been received by the
person at any time as a result of, or connection with, the commission
by the person of that offence, or those offences, to be property
received by the person free of any interests in it.
(4) Where a confiscation order has previously been made against a person,
in assessing the value of any benefit derived by the person from the commission
of the serious offence in respect of which the order was made, the Court shall
leave out of account any of the person’s benefits that are shown to the Court to
have been taken into account in determining the amount to be recovered under
that order.
1434

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(5) If evidence is given at the hearing of the application that the value of the person’s property at any time after the commission of the serious offence exceeded the value of the person’s property before the commission of the offence, then the Court shall, subject to subsection (6), treat the value of the benefits derived by the person from the commission of the offence as being not less than the amount of the excess.
(6) If, after evidence of the kind referred to in subsection (5) is given, the person satisfies the Court that the whole or part of the excess was due to causes unrelated to the commission of the offence, subsection (5) does not apply to the excess or, as the case may be, that part.

21 Statements relating to benefits from commission of serious offences

(1) Where –
(a) A person has been convicted of a serious offence and the Attorney-
General tenders to the Court a statement as to any matters relevant –
(i) to determining whether the person has benefited from the
offence or from any other serious offence of which the person
is convicted in the same proceedings or which is taken into
account in determining his sentence; or
(ii) to an assessment of the value of the person’s benefit from the
offence or any other serious offence of which he is so convicted
in the same proceedings or which is so taken into account; and
(b) The person accepts to any extent an allegation in the statement,
the Court may, for the purposes of so determining or making that assessment, treat his acceptance as conclusive of the matters to which it relates.
(2) Where –
(a) A statement is tendered under subsection (1)(a); and
(b) The Court is satisfied that a copy of that statement has been served
on the person,
the Court may require the person to indicate to what extent the person accepts
each allegation in the statement and, so far as the person does not accept any such
allegation, to indicate any matters the person proposes to rely on.
(3) Where the person fails in any respect to comply with a requirement
under subsection (2), the person may be treated for the purposes of this section as
having accepted every allegation in the statement, other than –
(a) An allegation in respect of which the person has complied with the
requirement; and
(b) An allegation that the person has benefited from the serious offence
or that any property or advantage was obtained by the person as a
result of, or in connection with, the commission of the offence.
(4) Where –
(a) The person tenders to the Court a statement as to any matters
relevant to determining the amount that might be realised at the
time the confiscation order is made; and
(b) The Attorney-General accepts to any extent any allegation in the
statement,
the Court may, for the purposes of that determination, treat the acceptance of the
Attorney-General as conclusive of the matters to which it relates.
(5) An allegation may be accepted or matter indicated for the purposes of
this section either –
(a) Orally before the Court; or
(b) In writing under rules of court.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1435
(6) An acceptance by a person under this section that he received any benefits from the commission of a serious offence is admissible in any proceedings for any offence.

22 Amount to be recovered under confiscation order

(1) Subject to subsection (2), the amount to be recovered in the person’s
case under a confiscation order shall be the amount which the Court assesses to
be the value of the person’s benefit from the offence or, if more than one, all the
offences in respect of which the order may be made.
(2) Where the Court is satisfied as to any matter relevant to determining
the amount which might be realised at the time the confiscation order is made
(whether by an acceptance under section 21 or otherwise) the Court may issue a
certificate giving the Court’s opinion as to the matters concerned, and shall do so
if satisfied that the amount that might be realised at the time the confiscation
order is made is less than the amount that the Court assesses to be the value of the
person’s benefit from the offence, or if more than one, all the offences in respect of
which the confiscation order may be made.

23 Variation of confiscation orders

(1) Where –
(a) The Court makes a confiscation order in relation to an offence;
(b) In calculating the amount of the confiscation order, the Court took
into account a forfeiture of property or a proposed forfeiture of
property or a proposed forfeiture order in respect of property; and
(c) An appeal against the forfeiture or forfeiture order is allowed or
the proceedings for the proposed forfeiture order terminate without
the proposed forfeiture order being made,
the Attorney-General may apply to the Court for a variation of the confiscation
order to increase the amount of the order by the value of the property and the
Court may, if it considers it appropriate to do so, vary the order accordingly.
(2) Where –
(a) The Court makes a confiscation order against a person in relation
to an offence;
(b) In calculating the amount of the confiscation order, the Court took
into account under section 5(5) and (6), an amount of tax paid by
the person; and
(c) An amount is repaid or refunded to the person in respect of that
tax,
the Attorney-General may apply to the Court for a variation of the confiscation
order to increase the amount of the order by the amount repaid or refunded and
the Court may, if it considers it appropriate to do so, vary the order accordingly.

24 Court may lift corporate veil

(1) In assessing the value of benefits derived by a person from the
commission of an offence or offences, the Court may treat as property of the person
any property that, in the opinion of the Court, is subject to the effective control of
the person whether or not the person has –
(a) Any legal or equitable interest in the property; or
(b) Any right, power or privilege in connection with the property.
1436 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the Court may have regard to –
(a) Shareholdings in, debentures over or directorships of a company that has an interest (whether direct or indirect) in the property, and for this purpose the Court may order the investigation and inspection of the books of a named company;
(b) A trust which has a relationship to the property; and
(c) Any relationship whatsoever between persons having an interest
in the property, or in companies of the kind referred to in paragraph
(a) or trusts of the kind referred to in paragraph (b), and other
persons.
(3) Where the Court, for the purposes of making a confiscation order against
a person, treats particular property as the person’s property under subsection (1),
the Court may, on application by the Attorney-General, make an order declaring
that the property is available to satisfy the order.
(4) Where the Court declares that property is available to satisfy a
confiscation order –
(a) The order may be enforced against the property as if the property
were property of the person against whom the order is made; and
(b) A restraining order may be made in respect of the property as if the
property were property of the person against whom the order is
made.
(5) Where the Attorney-General makes an application for an order under
subsection (3) that property is available to satisfy a confiscation order against a
person –
(a) The Attorney-General shall give written notice of the application to the person and to any person who the Attorney-General has reason to believe may have an interest in the property; and
(b) The person and any person who claims an interest in the property
may appear and adduce evidence at the hearing of the application.

25 Enforcement of confiscation orders

(1) An amount payable by a person to the Crown under a confiscation
order is a civil debt due by the person to the Crown.
(2) A confiscation order against a person may be enforced as if it were an
order made in civil proceedings instituted by the Crown against the person to
recover a debt due by the person to the Crown and the debt arising from the order
shall be taken to be a judgment debt.
(3) Where a confiscation order is made against a person and the person is,
or becomes a bankrupt, the order may be enforced against the person or against
any property of the person that is not vested in the person’s trustee under the
Niue Act 1966.

26 Amounts paid in respect of registered foreign confiscation orders

Where a foreign confiscation order is registered in the Court under the
Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998, any amount paid, whether in
Niue or elsewhere, in satisfaction of the foreign confiscation order shall be taken
to have been paid in satisfaction of the debt that arises by reason of the registration
of the foreign confiscation order in the Court.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1437
PART 3
PROVISIONS FOR FACILITATING POLICE INVESTIGATIONS AND PRESERVING PROPERTY LIABLE
TO FORFEITURE AND CONFISCATION ORDERS

Powers of Search and Seizure

27 Warrant to search land for tainted property

(1) A constable may apply to a Commissioner for the issue of a warrant to
search land or premises for tainted property.
(2) Where an application is made under subsection (1) for a warrant to
search land or premises for tainted property, the Commissioner may issue a warrant
of that kind in the same manner, and subject to the same conditions, as a judge
could issue a search warrant under the Niue Act 1966 and, subject to sections 27 to
30 of this Act, the warrant may be executed in the same manner as if it had been
issued under that Act.

28 Police may seize other tainted property

In the course of a search under a warrant issued under section 27 a constable
may seize –
(a) Any property that the constable believes, on reasonable grounds,
to be tainted property in relation to any serious offence;
(b) Any thing that the constable believes, on reasonable grounds, will
afford evidence as to the commission of a criminal offence,
if the constable believes, on reasonable grounds, that it is necessary to seize that
property or thing in order to prevent its concealment, loss or destruction, or its
use in committing, continuing or repeating the offence or any other offence.

29 Return of property seized

(1) Where property has been seized under sections 27 to 30 (otherwise than
because it may afford evidence of the commission of an offence), a person who
claims an interest in the property may apply to the Court for an order that the
property be returned to that person.
(2) Where a person makes an application under subsection (1) and the Court
is satisfied that –
(a) The person is entitled to possession of the property;
(b) The property is not tainted property in relation to the relevant
offence; and
(c) The person in respect of whose conviction, charging or proposed
charging the seizure of the property was made has no interest in
the property,
the Court shall order the Chief of Police to return the property to the person and
the Chief of Police shall arrange for the property to be returned.
(3) Where –
(a) Property has been seized under sections 27 to 30, otherwise than
because it may afford evidence as to the commission of an offence;
(b) At the time when the property was seized, an information had not
been laid in respect of a relevant offence; and
(c) At the end of the period of 48 hours after the time when the property
was seized, an information has not been laid in respect of a relevant
offence,
the Chief of Police shall, subject to subsections (5) and (6), arrange for the property
to be returned to the person from whose possession it was seized as soon as
practicable after the end of that period.
1438 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(4) Where –
(a) Property has been seized under sections 27 to 30, otherwise than
because it may afford evidence as to the commission of an offence;
and
(b) No forfeiture order has been made against the property within the
period of 14 days after the property was seized and the property is
in the possession of the Chief of Police at the end of that period;
the Chief of Police shall, subject to subsections (5) and (6), arrange for the property
to be returned to the person from whose possession it was seized as soon as
practicable after the end of that period.
(5) Where –
(a) Property has been seized under sections 27 to 30, otherwise than
because it may afford evidence as to the commission of an offence;
(b) But for this subsection, the Chief of Police would be required to
arrange for the property to be returned to a person as soon as
practicable after the end of a particular period; and
(c) Before the end of that period, a restraining order is made in relation
to the property,
the Chief of Police shall –
(d) If the restraining order directs the Financial Secretary to take custody
and control of the property – arrange for the property to be given
to the Financial Secretary in accordance with the restraining order;
(e) If the Court that made the restraining order has made an order under
subsection (6) in relation to the property – arrange for the property
to be kept until it is dealt with under another provision of this Act.
(6) Where –
(a) Property has been seized sections 27 to 30, other than because it
may afford evidence as to the commission of an offence;
(b) A restraining order is made in relation to the property; and
(c) At the time when the restraining order is made, the property is in
the possession of the Chief of Police,
the Chief of Police may apply to the Court that made the retraining order for an
order that the Chief of Police retain possession of the property and the Court may,
if satisfied that there are reasonable grounds for believing that the property may
afford evidence as to the commission of a relevant offence or any other offence,
make an order that the Chief of Police may retain the property for so long as the
property is so required as evidence as to the commission of that offence.
(7) Where the Chief of Police applies to the Court for an order under
subsection (6), a witness shall not be required to answer a question or to produce
a document if the Court is satisfied that the answering of the question or the
production of the document may prejudice the investigation of, or the prosecution
of a person for, an offence.
(8) Where –
(a) Property has been seized under sections 27 to 30; and
(b) While the property is in the possession of the Chief of Police, a
forfeiture order is made in respect of the property;
the Chief of Police shall deal with the property as required by the order.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1439

30 Search for and seizure of tainted property in relation to foreign offences

(1) Where a constable is authorised, under the Mutual Assistance in
Criminal Matters Act 1998, to apply to a Commissioner for a search warrant under this Act in relation to tainted property in respect of a foreign serious offence, the constable may apply for the warrant accordingly and sections 27 to 30 apply to the application and to any warrant issued as a result of the application as if –
(a) References in sections 27 to 30 to tainted property were references to tainted property in relation to a foreign serious offence; and
(b) References in sections 27 to 30 to a relevant offence were references
to a relevant foreign serious offence;
(c) References in sections 27 to 30 to seizure of property under sections
27 to 30 were references to seizure of property under a warrant
issued under section 27 in respect of a foreign serious offence;
(d) The reference in section 29(2)(c) to the person in respect of whose
conviction, charging or proposed charging the seizure of the
property was made were a reference to the person who is believed
or alleged to have committed the relevant foreign serious offence;
(e) The reference in section 29(4) to a period of 14 days were a reference
to a period of 30 days;
(f) The references in sections 29(5) and (6) to the making of a restraining
order in relation to seized property were references to –
(i) the registration in the Court under the Mutual Assistance in
Criminal Matters Act 1998 of a foreign restraining order in
relation to the seized property; or
(ii) the making by the Court under this Act of a restraining order
in respect of the seized property in relation to the foreign serious
offence;
(g) The reference in section 29(8) to the making of a forfeiture order
were a reference to the registration in the Court under the Mutual
Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998 of a foreign forfeiture order;
and
(h) Sections 28 and 29(3) were omitted.
(2) If, in the course of searching under a warrant issued under section 27,
for tainted property in relation to a foreign serious offence, a constable finds –
(a) Property that the constable believes, on reasonable grounds, to be
tainted property in relation to any foreign serious offence in respect
of which a search warrant under section 27 is in force; or
(b) Any thing that the constable believes, on reasonable grounds –
(i) to be relevant to a criminal proceeding in the foreign country
in respect of the foreign serious offence; or
(ii) will afford evidence as to the commission of a criminal offence,
and the constable believes, on reasonable grounds, that it is necessary to seize that
property or thing in order to prevent its concealment, loss or destruction, or its
use in committing, continuing or repeating the offence, the warrant shall be deemed
to authorise the constable to seize that property or thing.
1440 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Restraining Orders

31 Application for restraining order

(1) Where a person (in sections 31 to 46 called the “defendant”) –
(a) Has been convicted of a serious offence; or
(b) Has been, or is about to be, charged with a serious offence,
the Attorney-General may apply to the Court for a restraining order under
subsection (2) against any realisable property held by the defendant or specified
realisable property held by a person other than the defendant.
(2) An application for a restraining order may be made ex parte and shall
be in writing and be accompanied by an affidavit stating –
(a) Where the defendant has been convicted of a serious offence – the
offence of which the defendant was convicted, the date of the
conviction, the Court before which the conviction was obtained and
whether an appeal has been lodged against the conviction;
(b) Where the defendant has not been convicted of a serious offence –
the offence with which the defendant is, or is about to be, charged
and the grounds for believing that the defendant committed the
offence;
(c) Where the defendant is about to be charged with a serious offence
– the grounds for believing that the defendant will be charged with
a serious offence within 48 hours;
(d) A description of the property in respect of which the restraining
order is sought;
(e) The name and address of the person who is believed to be in
possession of the property;
(f) Where the application seeks a retraining order against property of
the defendant – the grounds for the belief that the property is tainted
property in relation to the offence or the defendant derived a benefit
directly or indirectly from the commission of the offence; and
(g) Where the application seeks a restraining order against property of
a person other than the defendant – the grounds for the belief that
the property is tainted property in relation to the offence or is subject
to the effective control of the defendant.

32 Restraining order

(1) Subject to this section, where the Attorney-General applies to the Court
for a restraining order against property and the Court is satisfied that –
(a) The defendant has been convicted of a serious offence or has been
charged with a serious offence or will be charged with a serious
offence within 48 hours;
(b) Where the defendant has not been convicted of the offence – there
are reasonable grounds for believing that the defendant committed
the offence;
(c) Where the application seeks a restraining order against property of
the defendant – there are reasonable grounds for believing that the
property is tainted property in relation to the offence or that the
defendant derived a benefit directly or indirectly from the
commission of the offence;
(d) Where the application seeks a restraining order against property of
a person other than the defendant – there are reasonable grounds
for believing that the property is tainted property in relation to the
offence or that the property is subject to the effective control of the
defendant,
the Court may make an order –

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1441
(e) Prohibiting the defendant or any person from disposing of, or otherwise dealing with, the property or such part of it or interest in it as is specified in the order, except in such manner as is specified in the order; and
(f) At the request of the Attorney-General, where the Court is satisfied that the circumstances so require – directing the Financial Secretary to take custody of the property or such part of it as is specified in the order and to manage or otherwise deal with all or any part of the property under the directions of the Court.
(2) An order under subsection (1) may be made subject to such conditions as the Court thinks fit and, without limiting the generality of this section, may make provision for meeting, out of the property or a specified part of the property, all or any of the following –
(a) The person’s reasonable living expenses (including the reasonable living expenses of the person’s dependants (if any)) and reasonable business expenses;
(b) The person’s reasonable expenses in defending a criminal charge and any proceedings under this Act;
(c) Another specified debt incurred by the person in good faith;
but the Court shall not make such provision unless it is satisfied that the person
cannot meet the expense or debt concerned out of property that is not subject to a
restraining order.
(3) In determining whether there are reasonable grounds for believing the
property is subject to the effective control of the defendant the Court may have
regard to the matters referred to in section 24(2).
(4) Where the Financial Secretary is given a direction under subsection
(1)(f) in relation to property, the Financial Secretary may do anything that is
reasonably necessary for preserving the property and for this purpose may exercise
any power that the owner of the property could exercise and do so to the exclusion
of the owner.
(5) Where the Attorney-General applies to the Court for an order under
subsection (1), a witness shall not be required to answer a question or to produce
a document if the Court is satisfied that answering the question or producing the
document may prejudice the investigation of, or prosecution of a person for, an
offence.

33 Undertakings by the Crown

(1) Before making an order under section 32, the Court may require the
Crown to give such undertakings as the Court considers appropriate with respect
to the payment of damages or costs, or both, in relation to the making and execution
of the order.
(2) For the purposes of this section, the Attorney-General may, on behalf
of the Crown, give to the Court such undertakings with respect to the payment of
damages or costs, or both, as are required by the Court.

34 Notice of application for restraining order

(1) Subject to subsection (2), before making a restraining order, the Court
shall require notice to be given to, and may hear, any person who, in the opinion
of the Court, may have an interest in the property.
(2) If the Attorney-General so requests, the Court shall consider the
application without requiring notice to be given under subsection (1) but a
restraining order made under this subsection shall cease to have effect after 14
days or such lesser period as the Court specifies in the order.
1442 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) The Court may, on application by the Attorney-General, extend the period of operation of a restraining order made under subsection (2), but shall not consider the application without requiring notice to be given under subsection (1).

35 Service of restraining order

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a copy of a restraining order shall be served
on a person affected by the order in such manner as the Court directs or as may be
prescribed by rules of Court.
(2) Where the Court is satisfied that it is in the public interest to do so it
may order that service under subsection (1) be delayed for a specified period.

36 Further orders

(1) Where the Court makes, or has made, a restraining order, the Court
may, on application by the Attorney-General, a person whose property is the subject
of the restraining order (in this section called “the owner”), the Financial Secretary
(if the restraining order directs the Financial Secretary to take custody and control
of property) or, with the leave of the Court, any other person, make any ancillary
orders it considers appropriate.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), an ancillary order
may –
(a) Vary the property to which a restraining order relates;
(b) Vary any condition to which a restraining order is subject;
(c) Order the examination on oath before the Court of any person about
the affairs of the owner or the defendant;
(d) Provide for the carrying out of any undertaking with respect to the
payment of damages or costs given by the Crown in connection
with the making of the restraining order;
(e) Direct the owner or the defendant to give to a specified person a
statement on oath setting out such particulars of the property, or
dealings with the property, as the Court thinks proper;
(f) Where the restraining order directs the Financial Secretary to take
custody and control of property –
(i) regulate the performance or exercise of the Financial Secretary’s
functions, duties or powers under the restraining order;
(ii) determine any question relating to the property;
(iii) direct a person to do any act or thing to enable the Financial
Secretary to take custody and control of the property;
(iv) where the restraining order provides that a person’s reasonable
expenses in defending a criminal charge be met out of the
property , direct that such expenses be taxed as provided in
the order before being met; and
(v) make provision for the payment to the Financial Secretary out
of the property of the costs, charges and expenses incurred in
connection with the performance or exercise by the Financial
Secretary of functions, duties or powers under the restraining
order.
(3) Where a person who has an interest in property in respect of which a
restraining order was made applies to the Court for a variation of the order to exclude the person’s interest from the order, the Court shall grant the application if the Court is satisfied –

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1443
(a) That the interest is not tainted property and that it cannot be required to satisfy a confiscation order; or
(b) That the applicant was not in any way involved in the commission of the offence in respect of which the restraining order was made and, where the applicant acquired the interest at the time of or after the commission (or alleged commission) of the offence, that the applicant acquired the interest –
(i) for sufficient consideration; and
(ii) without knowing, and in circumstances such as not to arouse a
reasonable suspicion, that the property was tainted property;
or
(c) in any case – it is in the public interest to do so having regard to all
the circumstances, including any financial hardship or other
consequence of the interest remaining subject to the order.
(4) An application under subsection (1) shall not be heard by the Court
unless the applicant has given to each other person who is entitled to make an
application under subsection (1) in relation to the restraining order notice in writing
of the application.
(5) The Court may require notice of the application to be given to, and
may hear, any person who, in the opinion of the Court, appears to have an interest
in the property.
(6) Where a person is required, under an order under subsection (2)(c) or
(e), to make or give a statement on oath, the person is not excused from making or
giving the statement on the ground that the statement, or part of the statement,
might tend to incriminate the person or make the person liable to forfeiture or a
penalty but such a statement, and any information, document or thing obtained
as a direct or indirect consequence of the statement, is not admissible against the
person in any criminal proceedings except a proceeding in respect of the falsity of
the statement.

37 Financial Secretary to satisfy confiscation order

(1) Where –
(a) A confiscation order is made against a defendant in reliance on the
defendant’s conviction of an offence; and
(b) A restraining order is made against property of the defendant, or
property of another person in relation to which an order under
section 24(3) is in force, in reliance on the defendant’s conviction,
or alleged commission, of the offence,
the Court may, upon the making of the later of the orders or, on application by the Attorney-General, at any time after it while the restraining order remains in force, direct the Financial Secretary to satisfy the confiscation order by a payment to the Crown out of the property.
(2) For the purposes of enabling the Financial Secretary to comply with a direction under subsection (1), the Court may –
(a) Direct the Financial Secretary to sell or otherwise dispose of such of the property as the Court specifies; and
(b) Order that the Financial Secretary may execute, and do anything
necessary to give validity and operation to, any deed or instrument
in the name of a person who owns or has an interest in the property,
and, where the Court makes such an order, the execution of the deed or instrument
by the Financial Secretary has the same force and validity as if the deed or
instrument had been executed by the person.
1444 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) The Financial Secretary shall refrain from taking action to sell property under a direction under subsection (1) –
(a) Until the relevant appeal date; or
(b) If proceedings in bankruptcy against the owner of the property are
in progress or the owner is bankrupt.
(4) In this section “relevant appeal date”, used in relation to a confiscation
order made in consequence of a person’s conviction of a serious offence, means –
(a) The date on which the period allowed by the rules of Court for the
lodging of an appeal against a person’s conviction, or for the lodging
of an appeal against the making of a confiscation order, expires
without an appeal having been lodged, whichever is the later; or
(b) Where an appeal against a person’s conviction or against the making
of a confiscation order is lodged – the date on which the appeal, or
the later appeal, lapses in accordance with the rules of court or is
finally determined.

38 Registration of restraining order

Where a restraining order applies to property of a particular kind and the
provisions of any law of Niue provide for the registration of title to, or charges
over, property of that kind, the authority responsible for administering those
provisions may, on application by the Attorney-General, record on the register
kept under those provisions the particulars of the restraining order and, if those
particulars are so recorded, a person who subsequently deals with the property
shall, for the purposes of section 39, be deemed to have notice of the restraining
order at the time of the dealing.

39 Contravention of restraining orders

(1) A person who knowingly contravenes a restraining order by disposing
of, or otherwise dealing with, property that is subject to the restraining order
commits an indictable offence punishable, on conviction, by –
(a) In the case of a natural person – a fine not exceeding 300 penalty
units or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 5 years, or both;
or
(b) In the case of a body corporate – a fine not exceeding 1500 penalty
units.
(2) Where a restraining order is made against property and the property is
disposed of, or otherwise dealt with, in contravention of the restraining order,
and the disposition or dealing was either not for sufficient consideration or not in
favour of a person who acted in good faith the Attorney-General may apply to the
Court that made the restraining order for an order that the disposition or dealing
be set aside.
(3) Where the Attorney-General makes an application under subsection
(2) in relation to a disposition or dealing, the Court may –
(a) Set aside the disposition or dealing as from the day on which the
disposition or dealing took place; or
(b) Set aside the disposition or dealing as from the day of the order
under this subsection and declare the respective rights of any
persons who acquired interests in the property on or after the day
on which the disposition or dealing took place and before the day
of the order under this subsection.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1445

40 Court may revoke restraining orders

(1) Where the Court has made a restraining order against a person’s
property, the Court may, on application by the person, revoke the order if the
applicant –
(a) Where the applicant is a defendant – gives security satisfactory to
the Court for the satisfaction of any confiscation order that may be
made against the person under this Act; or
(b) Gives undertakings satisfactory to the Court concerning the person’s
property.
(2) An applicant under subsection (1) shall give written notice of the
application to the Attorney-General and, if the restraining order directed the
Financial Secretary to take control of property, to the Financial Secretary.

41 When restraining order ceases to be in force

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a restraining order made in reliance on a
person’s conviction, or alleged commission, of a serious offence ceases to be in
force, in whole or in part, as the case requires –
(a) Where the order is made in reliance on the proposed charging of
the person with the offence and the person is not so charged within
the period of 48 hours after the making of the order – at the end of
that period;
(b) When the charge against the person is withdrawn or the person is
acquitted of the charge;
(c) When property subject to the order is used to satisfy a confiscation
order which was made in reliance on the person’s conviction of the
offence;
(d) When the Court refuses an application for a confiscation order in
reliance on the person’s conviction of the offence;
(e) When property subject to the order is forfeited under section 11 or
17.
(2) In spite of anything in subsection (1), a restraining order ceases to be in
force at the end of 6 months after the day when the restraining order was made
but the Court may within that period, on application by the Attorney-General,
order that the restraining order shall continue in force until a specified time or
event, if the Court is satisfied that a forfeiture order may still be made in respect of
the property or that the property may be required to satisfy a confiscation order
which has not yet been made.
(3) The Attorney-General shall give a person written notice of an
application under subsection (2) in relation to a restraining order in respect of
property of the person.

42 Interim restraining order may be made in respect of foreign offence

(1) Where the Attorney-General is authorised, under the Mutual Assistance
in Criminal Matters Act 1998, to apply for a restraining order under this Act against
any property of a person in respect of a foreign serious offence, the Attorney-
General may apply for the order accordingly and sections 31 to 46 apply to the
application and to any restraining order made as a result of the application as if –
(a) Reference in sections 31 to 46 to a serious offence were a reference
to the foreign serious offence;
(b) A reference in sections 31 to 46 to a person charged or about to be
charged with a serious offence were a reference to a person against
whom a criminal proceeding in respect of a foreign serious offence
1446

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

has commenced, or is reasonably believed to be about to commence, in a foreign country;
(c) There were substituted for the words of section 31(2)(b) the following words –
“where the defendant has not been convicted of a foreign serious offence – the offence which the defendant is believed to have committed and the grounds for that belief”;
(d) There were substituted for the words of section 32(1)(a) the following words –
“the defendant has been convicted of a foreign serious offence, or a criminal proceeding in respect of a foreign serious offence has commenced, or is reasonably believed to be about to commence, against the defendant in a foreign country”;
(e) The reference in section 32(2)(b) to a person’s reasonable expenses in defending a criminal charge includes a reference to the person’s reasonable expenses in being represented in a criminal proceeding in a foreign country; and
(f) Sections 31(2)(c) and (f), 32(1)(c), 36(3)(a), 37, 40 and 41 were omitted.
(2) Subject to subsections (3) and (4), a restraining order made in respect
of a foreign serious offence ceases to have effect at the end of the period of 30 days
commencing on the day on which the order is made.
(3) Where the Court makes a restraining order in respect of a foreign serious
offence, it may, on application made by the Attorney-General before the end of
the period referred to in subsection (2), extend the period of operation of the
restraining order.
(4) Where –
(a) A restraining order against property is made in respect of a foreign
serious offence; and
(b) Before the end of the period referred to in subsection (2) (including
that period as extended under subsection (3)) a foreign restraining
order against the property is registered in the Court under the
Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998,
the restraining order referred to in paragraph (a) ceases to have effect upon the
registration of the foreign restraining order referred to in paragraph (b).

43 Registered foreign restraining orders – general

Where a foreign restraining order is registered in the Court under the Mutual
Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998, sections 31 to 46 apply in relation to the order as if –
(a) Sections 36, 37(3) and (4), 40 and 41 were omitted;
(b) A reference in section 35, 37, 38 or 39 to a restraining order included
a reference to an order under section 44; and
(c) The reference in section 37(1) to the making of a restraining order
were a reference to the registration by the Court of a foreign
restraining order under the Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters
Act 1998 and the making of an order under section 44.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1447

44 Registered foreign restraining orders – Court may direct Financial

Secretary to take custody and control of property

(1) Where a foreign restraining order against property is registered in the
Court under the Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998, the Court may,
if satisfied, upon application by the Attorney-General, that the circumstances so
require, by order direct the Financial Secretary to take custody and control of the
property, or of such part of it as is specified in the Court order and to manage or
otherwise deal with all or any part of the property under the directions of the
Court.
(2) Before making an order under subsection (1), the Court shall require notice to be given to, and may hear, any person who, in the opinion of the Court, may have an interest in the property.
(3) Where the Financial Secretary is given an order under subsection (1) in relation to property, the Financial Secretary may do anything that is reasonably necessary for preserving the property and for this purpose may exercise any power that the owner of the property could exercise and do so to the exclusion of the owner.
(4) Where an order is made under subsection (1) in respect of property of
a person (in this subsection called the “respondent”), the Court may, at the time
when it makes the order or at any later time, make any one or more of the following
orders –
(a) Directing the respondent to give the Financial Secretary a statement on oath setting out such particulars of the property, or dealings with the property, as the Court thinks proper;
(b) Regulating the performance or exercise of the Financial Secretary’s functions, duties or powers under the restraining order;
(c) Determining any question relating to the property;
(d) Where the registered foreign restraining order provides that a
person’s reasonable expenses in defending a criminal charge be met
out of the property – directing that such expenses be taxed as
provided in the order before being met; and
(e) Making provision for the payment to the Financial Secretary out of
the property of the costs, charges and expenses incurred in
connection with the performance or exercise by the Financial
Secretary of functions, duties or powers under the restraining order.

45 Registered foreign restraining orders – undertakings

Where –
(a) A foreign restraining order against property is registered in the
Court under the Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998;
or
(b) The Court makes an order under section 44 in respect of property,
the Court may, upon application by a person claiming an interest in the property,
make an order as to the giving, or carrying out, of an undertaking by the Attorney-
General, on behalf of the Crown, with respect to the payment of damages or costs
in relation to the registration, making or operation of the order.
1448 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

46 Registered foreign restraining orders – time when order ceases to be in force

A foreign restraining order registered in the Court under the Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters 1998 ceases to be in force when the registration is cancelled under that Act.

Production Orders, and Other Information Gathering Powers

47 Production and inspection orders

(1) Where –
(a) A person has been convicted of a serious offence and a constable
has reasonable grounds for suspecting that a person has possession
or control of a property-tracking document or property-tracking
documents in relation to the offence; or
(b) A constable has reasonable grounds for suspecting that a person
has committed a serious offence and that a person has possession
or control of a property-tracking document or property-tracking
documents in relation to the offence;
the constable may apply to a Judge in Chambers under subsection (2) for an order
under subsection (5) against the person suspected of having possession or control
of the document or documents.
(2) An application under subsection (1) shall be made ex parte and shall be
in writing and be accompanied by an affidavit.
(3) Where a constable applies for an order under subsection (5) in respect
of an offence and includes in the affidavit a statement to the effect that the constable
has reasonable grounds to believe that –
(a) The person who was convicted of the offence, or who is believed to
have committed the offence, derived a benefit, directly or indirectly,
from the commission of the offence; and
(b) Property specified in the affidavit is subject to the effective control
of the person referred to in paragraph (a),
the Judge may treat any document relevant to identifying, locating or quantifying
that property as a property-tracking document in relation to the offence for the
purposes of this section.
(4) In determining whether to treat a document, under subsection (3), as a
property-tracking document in relation to an offence, the Judge may have regard
to the matters referred to in section 24(2).
(5) Subject to subsection (6), but notwithstanding any enactment which
prohibits disclosure of information of a particular type, where an application is
made under subsection (1) for an order against a person, the Judge may, if satisfied
that there are reasonable grounds for doing so, make an order requiring the person
to –
(a) Produce to a constable, at a specified time and place, any documents of the kind referred to in subsection (1) that are in the person’s possession or control; or
(b) Make available to a constable for inspection, at a specified time or times, any documents of that kind that are in the person’s possession or control.
(6) An order under subsection (5)(a) shall not be made in respect of accounting records used in the ordinary business of banking, including ledgers, day-books, cash books and account books.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1449

48 Scope of police powers under production order

(1) Where a document is produced to a constable, or made available to a
constable for inspection pursuant to an order under section 47, the constable may –
(a) Inspect the document;
(b) Take extracts from the document;
(c) Make copies of the document;
(d) In the case of an order under section 47(5)(a) – retain the document
if, and for so long as, retention of the document is reasonably
necessary for the purposes of this Act.
(2) Where a constable retains a document pursuant to an order under
section 47, the constable shall –
(a) Give the person to whom the order was addressed a copy of the
document certified by the constable in writing to be a true copy of
the document retained; and
(b) Unless the person has received a copy of the document under
paragraph (a) – permit the person to –
(i) inspect the document;
(ii) take extracts from the document; or
(iii) make copies of the document.

49 Evidential value of information

(1) Where a person produces or makes available a document pursuant to
an order under section 47, the production or making available of the document,
or any information, document or thing obtained as a direct or indirect consequence
of the production or making available of the document, is not admissible against
the person in any criminal proceedings except a proceeding for an offence against
section 51.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), proceedings on an application for a
restraining order, a forfeiture order or a confiscation order are not criminal
proceedings.
(3) A person is not excused from producing or making available a document
when required to do so by an order under section 47 on the ground that –
(a) The production or making available of the document might tend to
incriminate the person or make the person liable to penalty; or
(b) The production or making available of the document would be in
breach of an obligation (whether imposed by enactment or
otherwise) of the person not to disclose the existence or contents of
the document.

50 Variation of production order

Where a Judge makes a production order requiring a person to produce a
document to a constable, the person may apply to the Judge or another Judge for
a variation of the order and if the Judge hearing the application is satisfied that
the document is essential to the business activities of the person, the Judge may
vary the production order so that it requires the person to make the document
available to a constable for inspection.

51 Failure to comply with production order

(1) Where a person is required by a production order to produce a
document to a constable or make a document available to a constable for inspection,
the person commits an offence against this subsection if the person –
1450

52

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(a) Contravenes the order without reasonable excuse; or
(b) In purported compliance with the order produces or makes
available a document known to the person to be false or misleading
in a material particular without –
(i) indicating to the constable to whom the document is produced
or made available that the document is false or misleading and
the respect in which the document is false or misleading; and
(ii) providing correct information to the constable if the person is
in possession of, or can reasonably acquire, the correct
information.
(2) An offence against subsection (1) is punishable, on conviction, by –
(a) If the offender is a natural person – a fine not exceeding 300 penalty
units or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 5 years, or both;
or
(b) If the offender is a body corporate – a fine not exceeding 1500 penalty
units.

Search warrant to facilitate investigation

(1) Where –
(a) A person is convicted of a serious offence and a constable has
reasonable grounds for suspecting that there is in any premises a
property-tracking document in relation to the offence; or
(b) A constable has reasonable grounds for suspecting that a person
has committed a serious offence and there is in any premises a
property-tracking document in relation to the offence;
the constable may apply to a Judge for a warrant under subsection (4) to search the premises for the document.
(2) Where a constable applies for a warrant under subsection (4) in respect of an offence and includes in the affidavit a statement to the effect that the officer has reasonable grounds to believe that –
(a) The person who was convicted of the offence, or who is believed to have committed the offence, derived a benefit, directly or indirectly, from the commission of the offence; and
(b) Property specified in the affidavit is subject to the effective control of the person referred to in paragraph (a),
the Judge may treat any document relevant to identifying, locating or quantifying that property as a property-tracking document in relation to the offence for the purposes of this section.
(3) In determining whether to treat a document, under subsection (2), as a property-tracking document in relation to an offence, the Judge may have regard to the matters referred to in section 24(2).
(4) Subject to subsection (5), but notwithstanding any enactment which prohibits disclosure of information of a particular type, where an application is made under subsection (1) for a warrant to search premises for a property-tracking document, the Judge may, if satisfied that there are reasonable grounds for doing so, issue a warrant of that kind in the same manner, and subject to the same conditions, as a Judge could issue a search warrant under the Niue Act 1966 and, subject to sections 47 to 53, the warrant may be executed in the same manner as if it had been issued under that Act.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1451
(5) A Judge shall not issue a search warrant under subsection (4) unless the Judge is satisfied that –
(a) It would not be appropriate to make a production order in respect of the document; or
(b) The investigation for the purposes of which the search warrant is being sought might be seriously prejudiced if the constable does not gain immediate access to the document without notice to any person.
(6) Where a constable enters premises in execution of a warrant issued
under this section, the police officer may seize and retain –
(a) Any document which is likely to be of substantial value (whether
by itself or together with other documents) to the investigation for
the purpose of which the warrant was issued; and
(b) Any thing that the constable believes, on reasonable grounds, will
afford evidence as to the commission of a criminal offence.
(7) In this section “premises” includes any place and in particular any
building, receptacle, vehicle, vessel or aircraft.

53 Production orders and search warrants in relation to foreign offences

(1) Where a constable is authorised, under the Mutual Assistance in
Criminal Matters Act 1998, to –
(a) Apply to a Judge of the Court for a production order under this Act
in respect of a foreign serious offence; or
(b) Apply to the Court for a search warrant under this Act in relation
to a property-tracking document in respect of a foreign serious
offence;
the constable may apply for the order or warrant accordingly and sections 47 to
53 apply to the application and to any order or warrant issued as a result of the
application as if a reference in those sections to a serious offence were a reference
to the foreign serious offence.
(2) Where a constable takes possession of a document under a production
order made, or a warrant issued, in respect of a foreign serious offence, the constable
may retain the document for a period not exceeding one month pending a written
direction from the Attorney-General as to the manner in which the document is to
be dealt with (which may include a direction that the document is to be sent to an
authority of the foreign country that requested the issue of the warrant).

54 Monitoring orders

Monitoring Orders

(1) A constable may apply to a Judge in Chambers under subsection (2) for an order (in sections 54 and 55 called a “monitoring order”) directing a financial institution to give information to a constable.
(2) An application under subsection (1) shall be made ex parte and shall be in writing and be accompanied by an affidavit.
(3) A monitoring order shall direct a financial institution to give information obtained by the institution about transactions conducted through an account held by a particular person with the institution.
(4) A monitoring order shall apply in relation to transactions conducted during the period specified in the order, being a period commencing not earlier than the day on which notice of the order is given to the financial institution and ending not later than 3 months after the date of the order.
1452

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(5) A Judge shall not make a monitoring order unless the Judge is satisfied that there are reasonable grounds for suspecting that the person in respect of whose account the information is sought –
(a) Has committed, or is about to commit, a serious offence;
(b) Was involved in the commission, or is about to be involved in the
commission, of a serious offence; or
(c) Has benefited directly or indirectly, or is about to benefit directly
or indirectly, from the commission of a serious offence.
(6) A monitoring order shall specify –
(a) The name or names in which the account is believed to be held;
(b) The class of information that the institution is required to give; and
(c) The name of the constable to whom the information is to be given,
and the manner in which the information is to be given.
(7) Where a financial institution is, or has been, subject to a monitoring
order, the fact that the monitoring order has been made shall be disregarded for
the purposes of the application of sections 64 and 65 in relation to the institution.
(8) Where a financial institution that has been given notice of a monitoring
order knowingly –
(a) Contravenes the order; or
(b) Provides false or misleading information in purported compliance
with the order;
the institution is guilty of an offence against this subsection punishable, on
conviction, by a fine not exceeding 3000 penalty units.
(9) A reference in this section to a transaction conducted through an account
includes a reference to –
(a) The making of a fixed term deposit; and
(b) In relation to a fixed term deposit – the transfer of the amount
deposited, or any part of it, at the end of the term; and
(c) The opening, existence or use of a deposit box held by the institution.

55 Monitoring orders not to be disclosed

(1) A financial institution that is, or has been, subject to a monitoring order
shall not disclose the existence or the operation of the order to any person except – (a) The Chief of Police or a constable authorised in writing by the Chief
of Police to receive the information;
(b) An officer or agent of the institution, for the purpose of ensuring
that the order is complied with; or
(c) A legal practitioner or adviser, for the purpose of obtaining legal
advice or representation in relation to the order.
(2) A person of a kind referred to in subsection (1)(a), (b) or (c) to whom a
disclosure of the existence or operation of a monitoring order has been made
(whether under subsection (1) or a previous application of this subsection or
otherwise) shall not –
(a) Disclose the existence or operation of the order except to another
person of a kind referred to in subsection (1)(a), (b) or (c) for the
purposes of –
(i) if the disclosure is made by the Chief of Police or a constable –
the performance of that officer ’s duties;
(ii) if the disclosure is made by an officer or agent of the institution
– ensuring that the order is complied with or obtaining legal
advice or representation in relation to the order; or
(iii) if the disclosure is made by a legal practitioner – giving legal
advice or making representations in relation to the order; or

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1453
(b) When the person is no longer a person of a kind referred to in subsection (1)(a), (b) or (c) – make a record of, or disclose, the existence or the operation of the order in any circumstances.
(3) Nothing in subsection (2) prevents the disclosure by a person of a kind referred to in subsection (1)(a) of the existence or operation of a monitoring order –
(a) For the purposes of, or in connection with, legal proceedings; or
(b) In the course of proceedings before a court.
(4) A person of a kind referred to in subsection (1)(a) shall not be required
to disclose to any court the existence or operation of a monitoring order.
(5) A person who contravenes subsection (1) or (2) is guilty of an offence
punishable, on conviction by –
(a) If the person is a natural person – a fine not exceeding 600 penalty
units or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 10 years, or both;
or
(b) If the person is a body corporate – a fine not exceeding 3000 penalty
units.
(6) A reference in this section to disclosing the existence or operation of a
monitoring order to a person includes a reference to disclosing information to the
person from which the person could reasonably be expected to infer the existence
or operation of the monitoring order.

Obligations of financial institutions

56 Retention of records by financial institutions

(1) Subject to this section and to section 57, a financial institution shall
retain, in its original form, for the minimum retention period applicable to the document, a document that relates to a financial transaction carried out by the institution in its capacity as a financial institution, including, without limiting the generality of this, a document that relates to –
(a) The opening or closing by a person of an account with the
institution;
(b) The operation by a person of an account with the institution;
(c) The opening or use by a person of a deposit box held by the
institution;
(d) The telegraphic or electronic transfer of funds by the institution on
behalf of a person to another person;
(e) The transmission of funds between Niue and a foreign country or
between foreign countries on behalf of a person; or
(f) An application by a person for a loan from the institution, where a
loan is made to the person under the application.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to –
(a) A document of a type referred to in subsection (1)(b) that relates to
a single deposit, credit, withdrawal, debit or transfer of an amount
of money that does not exceed $2,000 or such higher amount as is
prescribed for the purposes of this paragraph; or
(b) A document –
(i) that is not a document given to the institution by or on behalf
of a customer, and
(ii) whose retention is not necessary in order to preserve a record
of the financial transaction concerned.
(3) A financial institution required to retain documents under this section
shall retain them on microfilm or in another way that makes retrieval of the
documents, or of the information contained in the documents, reasonably
practicable.
1454 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(4) A financial institution that contravenes subsection (1) or (3) is guilty of an offence against this section punishable, on conviction, by a fine not exceeding
300 penalty units.
(5) This section does not limit any other obligation of a financial institution
to retain documents.

57 Register of original documents

(1) Where a financial institution is required by law to release an original of
a document before the end of the minimum retention period applicable to the
document, the institution shall retain a complete copy of the document until the
period has ended or the original document is returned, whichever occurs first.
(2) The financial institution shall maintain a register of documents released
under subsection (1).
(3) A financial institution that contravenes subsection (1) or (2) is guilty of
an offence against this section punishable, on conviction, by a fine not exceeding
300 penalty units.

58 Communication of information to law enforcement authorities

(1) Where a financial institution is a party to a transaction and the institution
has reasonable grounds to suspect that information that the institution has
concerning the transaction –
(a) May be relevant to an investigation of, or the prosecution of, a person
for an offence; or
(b) May be of assistance in the enforcement of this Act or any regulations
made under it;
the institution may give the information to a constable or the Attorney-General.
(2) An action, suit or proceedings does not lie against –
(a) A financial institution; or
(b) An officer, employee or agent of a financial institution acting in the
course of the person’s employment or agency,
in relation to an action taken by the institution or person under subsection (1).
(3) Where a financial institution gives information to a constable or the
Attorney-General, under subsection (1), about the institution’s suspicion in relation
to a transaction to which the institution is a party, the institution, or an officer,
employee or agent of the institution, must not, unless required to do so under this
Act or any other Act, disclose to anyone else –
(a) That the institution has formed the suspicion; or
(b) That information has been given; or
(c) Any other information from which the person to whom the
information is disclosed could reasonably be expected to infer that
the suspicion had been formed or that the first-mentioned
information had been given.
(4) A financial institution, or an officer, employee or agent of the institution,
who contravenes subsection (3) is guilty of an offence punishable, on conviction
by –
(a) If the offender is a natural person – a fine not exceeding 120 penalty units, or imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 years, or both; or
(b) If the offender is a body corporate – a fine not exceeding 600 penalty units.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1455

59 Protection for financial instutitions

Where a financial institution, or a person who is an officer, employee or
agent of the institution, gives the information under section 58(1) as soon as
practicable after forming the belief referred to in that subsection, the institution
shall be taken for the purposes of sections 64 and 65 not to have been in possession
of that information at any time.

60 Interpretation

For the purposes of sections 56 to 60 –
“customer”, in relation to a financial institution, means a person by or on
behalf of whom a financial transaction of a type referred to in section
56(1) is carried out by the institution;
“financial institution” means –
(a) A bank;
(b) A building society;
(c) A credit union;
(d) A trust company;
(e) A finance company; or
(f) A deposit taking company, designated as such by the Minister
responsible for finance;
“minimum retention period” means –
(a) If the document relates to the opening of an account with the
institution – the period of 7 years after the day on which the account
is closed;
(b) If the document relates to the opening by a person of a deposit box
held by the institution – the period of 7 years after the day on which
the deposit box ceases to be used by the person; or
(c) In any other case – the period of 7 years after the day on which the
transaction takes place.

Disclosure of Information Held by Government Departments

61 Direction to disclose information

Notwithstanding any provision in any other law, the Attorney-General may
direct the person in charge of any Government department or statutory body to
disclose a document or information which is in the possession or under the control
of that person or to which that person may reasonably have access (not being a
document readily available to the public), if the Attorney-General is satisfied that
the information is relevant to –
(a) Establishing whether a serious offence has been, or is being,
committed; or
(b) The making, or proposed or possible making, of an order under
Part 2 or 3,
and, where the Attorney-General directs disclosure of information under this
subsection, the person shall disclose the information to the Attorney-General or a
constable nominated by the Attorney-General.
1456 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

62 Further disclosure of information and documents

(1) No person to whom information has been disclosed under section 61
shall further disclose the information except for the purposes of –
(a) The investigation of, or the prosecution, or proposed or possible
prosecution, of a person for a serious offence; or
(b) An investigation relating to proceedings, or proposed or possible
proceedings, for the making of an order under this Act or an
investigation relating to the making, or proposed or possible
making, of such an order.
(2) A person to whom information has been disclosed under subsection
(1) or this subsection shall not disclose the information to another person except
for the purposes referred to in subsection (1)(a) and (b).
(3) Where information is communicated to a person under section 61 or
subsection (1) or (2), the person –
(a) Shall not voluntarily give the information in evidence in a
proceeding before the Court other than a proceeding referred to in
subsection (1)(a) or (b); and
(b) Shall not be required to communicate the information to the Court.
(4) A person who discloses information in contravention of this section is
guilty of an offence punishable, on conviction, by a fine not exceeding 120 penalty
units or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 2 years, or both.

63 Evidential value of copies

Where any document is examined or provided pursuant to a direction under
section 61, the person by whom it is examined or to whom it is provided, or any
officer or person authorised for the purpose by the person in charge of the relevant
Government department or statutory body, may make or cause to be made one or
more copies of it and any copy purporting to be certified by the person in charge
of the relevant Government department or statutory body to be a copy made under
this section is evidence of the nature and content of the original document and
has the same probative force as the original document would have had if it had
been proved in the ordinary way.

64 Money laundering

PART 4
OFFENCES
(1) In this section “transaction” includes the receiving or making of a gift. (2) A person who engages in money laundering is guilty of an offence
punishable, on conviction, by –
(a) If the offender is a natural person – a fine not exceeding 1,200 penalty
units or imprisonment for period not exceeding 20 years, or both;
or
(b) If the offender is a body corporate – a fine not exceeding 10,000
penalty units.
(3) A person shall be taken to engage in money laundering if, and only if –
(a) The person engages, directly or indirectly, in a transaction that
involves money, or other property, that is proceeds of crime; or
(b) The person receives, possesses, conceals, disposes of or brings into
Niue any money, or other property that is proceeds of crime,
and the person knows, or ought reasonably to know, that the money or other
property is derived or realised, directly or indirectly, from some form of unlawful
activity.

Proceeds of Crime Act 1998

1457

65 Possession of property suspected of being proceeds of crime

(1) A person who receives, possesses, conceals, disposes of or brings into
Niue any money, or other property, that may reasonably be suspected of being
proceeds of crime is guilty of an offence punishable, on conviction, by –
(a) If the offender is a natural person – a fine not exceeding 200 penalty
units or imprisonment for a period not exceeding 2 years, or both;
or
(b) If the offender is a body corporate – a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty
units.
(2) It is a defence to a charge for an offence against this section, if the person
satisfies the Court that the person had no reasonable grounds for suspecting that
the property referred to in the charge was derived or realised, directly or indirectly,
from some form of unlawful activity.

66 Conduct by directors, servants or agents

(1) Where it is necessary, for the purposes of this Act, to establish the state
of mind of a body corporate in respect of conduct engaged in, or deemed by
subsection (2) to have been engaged in, by the body corporate, it is sufficient to
show that a director, servant or agent of the body corporate, being a director, servant
or agent by whom the conduct was engaged in within the scope or his or her
actual or apparent authority, had that state of mind.
(2) Any conduct engaged in on behalf of a body corporate –
(a) By a director, servant or agent of the body corporate within the
scope of his or her actual or apparent authority; or
(b) By any other person at the direction or with the consent or agreement
(whether express or implied) of a director, servant or agent of the
body corporate, where the giving of the direction, consent or
agreement is within the scope of the actual or apparent authority
of the director, servant, or agent,
shall be deemed, for the purposes of this Act, to have been engaged in by the body
corporate.
(3) Where it is necessary, for the purposes of this Act, to establish the state
of mind of a person in relation to conduct deemed by subsection (4) to have been
engaged in by the person, it is sufficient to show that a servant or agent of the
person, being a servant or agent by whom the conduct was engaged in within the
scope of his or her actual or apparent authority, had that state of mind.
(4) Conduct engaged in on behalf of a person other than a body corporate –
(a) By a servant or agent of the person within the scope of his or her
actual or apparent authority; or
(b) By any other person at the direction or with the consent or agreement
(whether expressed or implied) of a servant or agent of the first-
mentioned person, where the giving of the direction, consent or
agreement is within the scope of the actual or apparent authority
of the servant or agent,
shall be deemed, for the purposes of this Act, to have been engaged in by the first-
mentioned person.
(5) A reference in this section to the state of mind of a person includes a
reference to the knowledge, intention, opinion, belief or purpose of the person
and the person’s reasons for the person’s intention, opinion, belief or purpose.
1458 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

67 Standard of proof

PART 5
MISCELLANEOUS
Save as otherwise provided in this Act, any question of fact to be decided by the Court in proceedings under this Act is to be decided on the balance of probabilities.

68 Costs

Where –
(a) A person brings, or appears at, proceedings under this Act before a
Court in order –
(i) to prevent a forfeiture, confiscation or restraining order from
being made against property of the person; or
(ii) to have property of the person excluded from a forfeiture,
confiscation or restraining order;
(b) The person is successful in those proceedings; and
(c) The Court is satisfied that the person was not involved in any way
in the commission of the offence in respect of which the forfeiture,
confiscation or restraining order was sought or made,
the Court may order the Crown to pay all costs reasonably incurred by the person
in connection with the proceedings or such part of those costs as is determined by
the Court.

69 Non-liability of Financial Secretary

The Financial Secretary shall not be personally liable for any act done, or
omitted to be done, by him or her in the course of the performance of the Financial
Secretary’s functions under this Act.

70 Operation of other laws not affected

Nothing in this Act prejudices, limits or restricts –
(a) The operation of any other law which provides for the forfeiture of
property or the imposition of penalties or fines; or
(b) The remedies available to the Crown, apart from this Act, for the
enforcement of its rights and the protection of its interests; or
(c) Any power of search or any power to seize or detain property which
is exercisable by a constable apart from this Act.

71 Regulations

The Cabinet may make regulations prescribing matters –
(a) Required or permitted by this Act to be prescribed; or
(b) Necessary or convenient to be prescribed for carrying out or giving
effect to this Act.
1459

PROPERTY LAW ACT 1952

1952/51 (NZ) – 1 January 1953

60 Alienation with intent to defraud creditors

61-62 [Repealed]

PART 5

COVENANTS AND POWERS

63 Benefit of covenants relating to land

64 Burden of covenants relating to land

65 Effect of covenant with 2 or more jointly

66 Covenants and agreements made by a

person with himself and others

66A Covenants and agreements made by a

person with himself

67 Covenants to be joint and several

68 Implied covenants may be negatived

69 Benefit of covenant for title

70-71 [Repealed]

14-30 [Repealed]

31 Release of part of land charged not to be

extinguishment of rent

32 Corporations may hold as joint tenants

33 Alienation of property may be restricted

33A Restrictions on ground of colour, race to

be void

34 Disclaimer of powers

35 Intermediate income of contingent or

executory gifts

36 Receipts for income by married infants

37 “Heirs” and other words interpreted

38 “Heirs of the body” and other words

interpreted

39 [Repealed]

40 Appointments valid notwithstanding

objects excluded

41-42 [Repealed]

PART 3

43-49 [Repealed]

PART 4

POWERS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE AND PROTECTION

OF PURCHASERS AND CREDITORS

50-59 [Repealed]

PART 6

COVENANTS IMPLIED IN CONVEYANCES

72 Covenants implied in conveyance by way

of sale

73 Covenants implied in conveyance subject

to encumbrance

74 Covenants implied in conveyance of term

of years

75 Covenants implied in conveyance by

trustees

PART 7

76-104 [Repealed]

PART 8

LEASES AND TENANCIES

General Provisions

105 Tenancy from year to year not to be

implied

106 Covenants implied in leases

107 Powers in lessor

108 Effect of licence to assign

109 No fine for licence to assign

110 Licence or consent not to be unreasonably

withheld

111 Merger of reversion not to affect remedies

112 Rent and benefit of lessee’s covenants to

run with reversion

1460 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

113 Obligation of lessor ’s covenants to run with reversion

114 Apportionment of conditions on severance

115 Restriction on effect of waiver

116 Executor not personally liable for

covenants

Relief Against Forfeiture

117 Interpretation

118 Restriction on and relief against forfeiture

119 Protection of underlessees on forfeiture

of superior leases

Relief Against Refusal to Grant Renewal

120 Relief of lessee against refusal of lessor to

grant a renewal or to assure the reversion

121 Limitation of time for application for relief

PART 9

EASEMENTS, RESTRICTIVE STIPULATIONS, AND

ENCROACHMENTs

122 Easement in gross permitted

123 Access or use of light or air

124-126 [Repealed]

127 Power for Court to modify or extinguish

easements and restrictive stipulations

128 Commissioner may authorise entry for

erecting or repairing buildings

129 Power of Court to grant special relief in

cases of encroachment

129A Relief in cases of mistake as to boundaries

or identity of land

PART 10

ASSIGNMENTS OF THINGS IN ACTION

139 Assignment of debts and things in action

PART 11

MARRIAGE SETTLEMENTS

131-132 [Repealed]

133 Sanction of Court to be obtained

PART 12

POWERS OF ATTORNEY

134 Execution by attorney in his own name

135 Continuance until notice of death or revocation received

136 Irrevocable power of attorney for value

137 Power of attorney made irrevocable for

fixed time

138 Conveyance under power of attorney

from person not in Niue

139 Application to corporations

PART 13

PARTITION OF LAND AND DIVISION OF CHATTELS

140 In action for partition Court may direct

land to be sold

141 Proceeds of sale, how applied

142 Costs in partition suits

143 Division of chattels

PART 14

APPORTIONMENT

144 Interpretation

145 Income apportionable in respect of time

146 Time when apportioned part payable

147 Recovery of apportioned parts

148 Exceptions and application

PART 15

149 [Repealed]

PART 16

RENTCHARGES AND OTHER ANNUAL SUMS

150 Recovery of annual sums charged on land

151 [Repealed]

PART 17

SERVICE OF NOTICES

152 Service of notices

PART 18

MISCELLANEOUS

153 [Repealed]

154 Protection of solicitors and trustees

155 [Spent]

Property Law Act 1952

To consolidate and amend certain enactments relating to property

1 Short title

This is the Property Law Act 1952.
1461

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“conveyance” includes any deed of assignment, appointment, lease,
settlement, or other assurance by deed of any property; and “convey”
has a corresponding meaning;
“encumbrance” includes a mortgage in fee or for a less estate, and a trust
for securing money, and a lien, and a charge of a portion, annuity, or
other capital or annual sum; and “encumbrance: has a corresponding
meaning and includes every person entitled to the benefit of an
encumbrance or entitled to require payment or discharge thereof;
“executors” and “administrators” of a deceased person mean respectively
the persons to whom the right to administer the estate of the deceased
has been granted by the proper court, whether for general, special, or
limited purposes; and “executors” includes executors by right of
representation;
“income”, when used with reference to land, includes rents and profits;
“instrument” includes deed, will, Proclamation taking land, and Act of
Parliament;
“possession”, when used with reference to land, includes the receipt of
income from it;
“property” includes real and personal property, and any estate or interest
in any property real or personal and any debt, and anything in action,
and any other right or interest;
“purchaser” includes a lessee or mortgagee, or other person who for
valuable consideration takes or deals for any property; and “purchase”
has a corresponding meaning; but “sale” means only a sale properly so
called;
“rent” includes yearly or other rent, toll, duty, royalty, or other reservation
by the acre, the ton, or otherwise; and “fine” includes premium or
foregift, and any payment, consideration, or benefit in the nature of a
fine, premium, or foregift;
“will” includes codicil.

3 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 1
DEEDS AND OTHER INSTRUMENTS

4 Formalities of deed

(1) Every deed, whether or not affecting property, shall be signed by the
party to be bound by it and shall also be attested by at least 1 witness and, if the
deed is executed in Niue, the witness shall add to his signature his place of abode
and calling or description, but no particular form of words shall be requisite for
the attestation.
(2) Except where the party to be bound by a deed is a corporation, sealing
is not necessary.
(3) Formal delivery and indenting are not necessary in any case.
(4) Every deed executed as required by this section shall be binding on the
party purported to be bound by it.
1462 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(5) Every deed, including a deed of appointment, executed before the commencement of this Act which is attested in the manner required or authorised by any enactment providing for the execution and attestation of deeds in force at the time of execution, or at any time subsequent to it, shall be deemed to be and to have been as valid and effectual as if it had been attested as required by this section.

5 Deed by corporation

Any deed that may be lawfully made by a corporation –
(a) To which the common or official seal of the corporation is affixed;
or
(b) Which is executed in the name of the corporation by any person
who has been appointed its attorney, and has at the time of execution
made a statutory declaration that he is the attorney of the
corporation acting under a power of attorney specified by him, and
that he has executed the deed under the powers by it conferred,
and that he has not at the time of making the declaration received
any notice of the revocation of the power of attorney by the
dissolution of the corporation or otherwise,
shall be deemed to have been duly executed by the corporation, and shall bind
the corporation; and all persons dealing in good faith without notice of any
irregularity shall be entitled to presume the regular and proper execution of the
deed, and to act accordingly.

6 Receipt for consideration money

An acknowledgement of the receipt of the consideration contained in the
body of a deed shall be as valid and effectual in all respects as if the same had also
been endorsed on it.

7 Person not named may take benefit

Any person may take an immediate benefit under a deed, although not
named as a party to it.

8 Construction of supplemental or annexed deed

A deed expressed to be supplemental to a previous deed, or directed to be
read as an annex to it, shall, as far as may be, be read and have effect as if the deed
so expressed or directed were made by way of endorsement on the previous deed,
or contained a full recital thereof.

9 Exercise of powers

Where a power of appointment by deed or writing, otherwise than by will,
is exercised by deed executed in the manner required by this Act, the deed shall
be deemed to be a valid exercise of the power, notwithstanding that by the
instrument creating the power some additional or other form of execution is
required.

10 Partitions, exchanges

No partition, exchange, lease, assignment, or surrender (otherwise than by
operation of law) of any land shall be valid at law unless the same is made by
deed, except a lease for a term not exceeding a tenancy of 1 year, which lease may
be made either by writing or by parol.

Property Law Act 1952

1463

11 Appointments

No appointment to be made by deed or writing (otherwise than by will) in
exercise of a power shall be valid unless the same is executed as a deed is hereby
required to be executed.

12 Disclaimers

No disclaimer of any land shall be valid unless the same is made by deed
or by matter of record.

13 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 2
GENERAL RULES AFFECTING PROPERTY

14-23 [Repealed by 2004/270]

24-25 [Repealed]

26 [Repealed by 2004/270]

27 [Repealed by s 5 of the Simultaneous Deaths Act 1958]

28-30 [Repealed by 2004/270]

31 Release of part of land charged not to be extinguishment of rent

(1) The release from a rent of any part of the land out of which it is payable
shall not be a discharge of the residue of the land from the rent.
(2) Where the owner of the part released is not the owner of the residue of
the land charged with the rent, the owner of the residue shall be entitled to the
same contribution from the owner of the part released as he would have been
entitled to if no release had been made.

32 Corporations may hold as joint tenants

(1) (a) A body corporate shall be capable of acquiring and holding any
property in joint tenancy in the same manner as if it were an
individual, and where a body corporate and an individual or 2 or
more bodies corporate become entitled to any property under
circumstances or by virtue of any instrument which would, if the
body corporate had been an individual, have created a joint tenancy
they shall be entitled to the property as joint tenants.
(b) The acquisition and holding of property by a body corporate in
joint tenancy shall be subject to the like conditions and restrictions
as attach to the acquisition and holding of property by a body
corporate in severalty.
(2) Where a body corporate is a joint tenant of any property, then on its
dissolution the property shall devolve on the other joint tenant.

33 Alienation of property may be restricted

(1) It shall be lawful by will, or by a settlement made on marriage, to
provide that any estate or interest in any property comprised in the will or
settlement devised, bequeathed, settled, or given to any beneficiary, whether male
or female, shall not during the life of that beneficiary be alienated, or pass by
bankruptcy, or be liable to be seized, sold, attached, or taken in execution by process
of law.
1464 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) [Repealed 2/121/1971 (NZ)]
(3) Nothing in this section shall prevent any lawful restraint on alienation
of property from being imposed by will or settlement.
(4) The Court may in any case where it appears to be for the benefit of the
person subject to any restraint on alienation either wholly or partly remove the
restraint.

33A Restrictions on ground of colour, race to be void

(1) Any provision in or in connection with any disposition of property
(whether oral or in writing) made after the commencement of this section shall be
void to the extent that its effect would be to prohibit or restrict the transfer,
assignment, letting, subletting, charging, or parting with the possession of the
property or any part of it, by any party to the disposition or his successor in title,
to any person by reason only of the colour, race, or ethnic or natural origins of that
person or of any member of his family.
(2) For the purposes of this section, “disposition” means –
(a) A sale, lease or letting, sublease or subletting, or licence; or
(b) A mortgage; or
(c) An agreement for any such disposition.
(3) This section shall bind the Crown.

34 Disclaimer of powers

(1) A person to whom is given any power, whether coupled with an interest
or not, may by deed release or contract not to exercise the power.
(2) Any such person as aforesaid may by deed disclaim any such power,
and after disclaimer shall not be capable of exercising or joining in the exercise of
the power.
(3) On any such disclaimer the power may be exercised by the other or
others, or the survivors or survivor of the others, of the persons to whom the
power is given, unless the contrary is expressed in the instrument creating the
power.

35 Intermediate income of contingent or executory gifts

(1) A contingent or future specific or residuary devise or bequest of
property, and a specific or residuary devise or bequest of property upon trust for
a person whose interest is contingent or executory, shall, subject to the statutory
provisions relating to accumulations, carry the intermediate income of that
property from the death of the testator except so far as the income or any part of it
may be otherwise expressly disposed of.
(2) Where under an instrument other than a will property stands limited
to a person for a contingent or future interest, or stands limited to trustees upon
trust for a person whose interest is contingent or executory, that interest shall,
subject to the statutory provisions relating to accumulations, carry the intermediate
income of that property from the time when the instrument comes into operation,
except so far as the income or any part of it may be otherwise expressly disposed
of.

36 Receipts for income by married infants

A married infant shall have power to give valid receipts for all income
(including statutory accumulations of income made during the minority) to which
the infant may be entitled in like manner as if the infant were of full age.

Property Law Act 1952

1465

37 “Heirs” and other words interpreted

(1) Where under the terms of any instrument coming into operation after
the commencement of this Act any property vests in –
(a) The heir or heirs of any person; or
(b) The next of kin of any person; or
(c) The next of kin of any person to be determined under the
Administration Act 1969 –
the property shall vest in the persons who on the death of the person intestate
would be beneficially entitled to his real and personal estate under the said last-
mentioned Act, and in the same shares.
(2) This section applies only if and so far as a contrary or other intention is
not expressed in the instrument, and shall have effect subject to the terms of the
instrument and to the provisions it contains.

38 “Heirs of the body” and other words interpreted

(1) Where under the terms of any instrument any property vests in –
(a) The heir or heirs of the body of any person; or
(b) The heir or heirs male of any person, or the heir or heirs male of the
body of any person; or
(c) The heir or heirs female of any person, or the heir or heirs female of
the body of any person, –
the property shall vest as follows –
In case (a) in the issue of that person as tenants in common

per stirpes; and

In case (b) in the sons and issue of sons of that person as tenants in common

per stirpes; and

In case (c) in the daughters and the issue of daughters of that person as
tenants in common per stirpes.
(2) This section applies only if and so far as a contrary or other intention is
not expressed in the instrument, and shall have effect subject to the terms of the
instrument and to the provisions it contains.

39 [Repealed]

40 Appointments valid notwithstanding objects excluded

(1) An appointment in exercise of any power to appoint any property
amongst several objects shall be valid and effectual notwithstanding that any 1 or
more of the objects do not by the appointment or in default of appointment take a
share or shares of the property.
(2) Nothing in this section shall prejudice or affect any provision in any
instrument creating any power which declares the amount of the share or shares
from which no object of the power shall be excluded, or some one or more object
or objects shall not be excluded.

41-42 [Repealed]

1466 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

43-49 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 3
PART 4
POWERS AND CONDITIONS OF SALE AND PROTECTION OF PURCHASERS AND CREDITORS

50-52 [Repealed by 2004/270]

53 [Repealed]

54-59 [Repealed by 2004/270]

60 Alienation with intent to defraud creditors

(1) Save as provided by this section, every alienation of property with intent
to defraud creditors shall be voidable at the instance of the person prejudiced.
(2) This section does not affect the law of bankruptcy for the time being in
force.
(3) This section does not extend to any estate or interest in property
alienated to a purchaser in good faith not having at the time of the alienation, notice of the intention to defraud creditors.

61-62 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 5
COVENANTS AND POWERS

63 Benefit of covenants relating to land

(1) A covenant, whether express or implied under this or any other Act,
relating to any land of the covenantee shall, unless a contrary intention is expressed,
be deemed to be made with the covenantee and his successors in title and the
persons deriving title under him or them, and, subject as aforesaid, shall have
effect as if those successors and other persons were expressed.
(2) For the purposes of this section in connection with covenants restrictive
of the user of land, “successors in title” shall be deemed to include the owners
and occupiers for the time being of the land of the covenantee intended to be
benefited.

64 Burden of covenants relating to land

(1) A covenant, whether express or implied under this or any other Act,
relating to any land of a covenantor or capable of being bound by him by covenant
shall, unless a contrary intention is expressed, be deemed to be made by the
covenantor on behalf of himself and his successors in title and the persons deriving
title under him or them, and, subject as aforesaid, shall have effect as if those
successors and other persons were expressed.
(2) This section extends to a covenant to do some act relating to the land,
notwithstanding that the subject-matter may not be in existence when the covenant
is made.
(3) For the purposes of this section in connection with covenants restrictive
of the user of land, “successors in title” shall be deemed to include the owners
and occupiers for the time being of the land.

Property Law Act 1952

1467

65 Effect of covenant with 2 or more jointly

(1) A covenant, whether express or implied under this or any other Act,
and a contract by deed, and a bond or obligation by deed, made with 2 or more
jointly, to pay money, or to make a conveyance, or to do any other act to them or
for their benefit, shall be deemed to include, and shall by virtue of this Act imply,
an obligation to do the act to or for the benefit of the survivor or survivors of
them, and to or for the benefit of any other person on whom devolves the right to
sue on the covenant, contract, bond, or obligation.
(2) This section applies only to a covenant, contract, bond, or obligation
made expressly or by implication on or after 1 January 1906 and then only in so
far as a contrary intention is not expressed in the deed containing the covenant or
contract, or in the bond or obligation, and shall have effect subject to its provisions.

66 Covenants and agreements made by a person with himself and others

A covenant, whether express or implied under this or any other Act, or an
agreement made by a person with himself and another or others, shall be construed
and be capable of being enforced in like manner as if the covenant or agreement
had been made with the other or others.

66A Covenants and agreements made by a person with himself

A covenant (whether express or implied under this or any other Act), or an
agreement, made by a person with himself as an incident of or with respect to or
for the purpose of any conveyance or mortgage of property under section 47,
shall be capable of being enforced in like manner as if the covenant or agreement
had been made by that person with another person.

67 Covenants to be joint and several

Where under a covenant, whether express or implied under this or any
other Act, more persons than one are covenantors, the covenant shall, unless a
contrary intention is expressed, be deemed to bind the covenantors and any 2 or
greater number of them jointly and each of them severally.

68 Implied covenants may be negatived

(1) A covenant or power implied under this or any other Act shall have
the same force and effect, and may be enforced in the same manner, as if it had
been set out at length in the deed wherein it is implied.
(2) Any such covenant or power may be negatived, varied or extended in
the deed, or by a memorandum in writing endorsed on it and executed as a deed
is required to be executed by the parties to the deed intended to be bound by it.

69 Benefit of covenant for title

The benefit of a covenant for title implied under this or any other Act shall
be annexed and incident to and shall go with the estate and interest of the implied
covenantee, and may be enforced by any person in whom that estate or interest is,
for the whole or any part of it vested.

70-71 [Repealed by 2004/270]

1468

72

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 6
COVENANTS IMPLIED IN CONVEYANCES

Covenants implied in conveyance by way of sale

(1) In every conveyance by way of sale, mortgage, marriage settlement, or
lease and in every other conveyance for valuable consideration, there shall be implied (except as provided by section 75) the following covenants by the person or each of the persons who conveyans, so far as regards the estate or interest expressed to be conveyed by him, with the person to whom the conveyance is made, or with the person jointly to whom the conveyance is made as joint tenants or with each of the persons to whom the conveyance is made as tenants in common, that is to say –
(a) A covenant for right to convey, meaning a covenant that the
conveying party has good right and full power to convey and assure
the estate or interest purported to be conveyed, and that free and
clear from all encumbrances other than such as are mentioned in
the conveyance;
(b) A covenant for quiet enjoyment, meaning a covenant that the party
to whom the estate or interest is purported to be conveyed, and all
persons claiming under him, shall quietly enjoy the same without
any disturbance by any person;
(c) A covenant for further assurance, meaning a covenant that the
conveying party, his executors or administrators, and all other
persons having or claiming any interest in the subject-matter of the
conveyance, will, at the cost of the person requiring the same, do
and execute all such acts and conveyances for the better assuring
of the estate or interest purported to be conveyed by it as may be
reasonably required by the party to whom the same is conveyed or
any person claiming under him;
(d) A covenant for production of title deeds, meaning a covenant that
the conveying party, his executors, administrators, or assigns, at
the request and cost of the grantee, his executors, administrators or
assigns, will, unless prevented by fire or other inevitable accident,
produce to him or them, or as he or they may direct, within Niue
all registered deeds and instruments or evidences of title in the
possession of the conveying party, and relating to the land conveyed
as well as to other land; and also that the conveying party, his
executors, administrators, and assigns, will, unless prevented as
aforesaid, keep the said deeds and instruments or evidences of title
in the meantime safe, whole, and uncancelled. This covenant shall
run with the land, so as to bind only the person for the time being
entitled to the possession of the deeds, instruments, or evidences
of title.
(2) The covenants for right to convey, for quiet enjoyment, and for further
assurance shall, except in the case of a mortgage, be restricted to the acts, deeds
and defaults of the conveying party, and of all persons through whom he derives
title otherwise than by purchase for value, and of all persons claiming or to claim
through, under, or in trust for him, or through or under any persons through
whom he derives title as aforesaid.
(3) The costs of any further assurance or production of title deeds required
by a mortgagee under the implied covenants in that behalf shall during the
continuance of the mortgage be borne by the mortgagor.

Property Law Act 1952

1469
(4) The covenant for quiet enjoyment shall not be implied against any mortgagor until default in payment of the principal moneys secured by the mortgage at the time fixed for the repayment of it, or in payment of interest on it, or until breach of any covenant by the mortgagor contained or implied in the mortgage; and until such default or breach as aforesaid it shall not be lawful for a mortgagee to enter into possession of the mortgaged land.

73 Covenants implied in conveyance subject to encumbrance

(1) In every conveyance by way of sale subject to an encumbrance there
shall be implied a covenant by the person to whom the property is conveyed with
the person making the conveyance to pay the moneys or perform the obligations
secured by the encumbrance, and to perform ad observe the covenants and
provisions of the encumbrance, and to keep harmless and indemnified the person
making the conveyance in respect of all such moneys, obligations, covenants, and
provisions.
(2) This section applies only in so far as a contrary intention is not expressed
in the conveyance, and shall have effect subject to the provisions of the conveyance.

74 Covenants implied in conveyance of term of years

In every conveyance of a term of years in land by way of sale or marriage
settlement, and in every other conveyance of a term of years in land for valuable
consideration, not being by way of mortgage, there shall be implied (except as
provided by section 75) the following covenants by each conveying party severally,
for himself, his executors and administrators, to the extent of the interest parted
with by him, but restricted to the acts, deeds, and defaults of the conveying party,
and of all persons through whom he derives title otherwise than by purchase for
value, and of all persons claiming through, under, or in trust for him, them, or any
of them, that is to say –
That the rent reserved by the lease under which the land is held, and the
covenants and conditions expressed or implied in the lease and to be performed
and observed by the lessee, have been respectively paid, performed, and observed
up to the date of the conveyance.

75 Covenants implied in conveyance by trustees

(1) Where any person conveys as trustee or mortgagee, or as executor or
administrator of a deceased person, or as manager of a mentally disordered person,
when appointed or acting as manager of a mentally disordered person’s estate or
where any person conveys under an order of the Court, or in a fiduciary capacity,
the covenants set out in section 72(1)(a),(b) and (c) and in section 74 shall not be
implied, but there shall be implied the following covenant on the part of the person
conveying, which covenant shall be deemed to extend to his own acts only,
namely –
That he has not executed or done, or knowingly suffered, or been party or
privy to, any deed or thing whereby or by means whereof the subject-matter of
the conveyance or any part of it is or may be impeached, charged, affected, or
encumbered in title, estate, or otherwise, or whereby or by means whereof he is in
any wise hindered from conveying the subject-matter of the conveyance or any
part of it in the manner in which it is expressed to be conveyed.
(2) The covenant implied by this section shall be deemed to be implied in
every memorandum of discharge endorsed on or annexed to a mortgage in the
same manner as if the memorandum were a deed of conveyance by the mortgagee.
1470 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

76-104 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 7
PART 8
LEASES AND TENANCIES

General Provisions

105 Tenancy from year to year not to be implied

No tenancy from year to year shall be created or implied by payment of
rent; and if there is a tenancy it shall be deemed in the absence of proof to the
contrary to be a tenancy determinable at the will of either of the parties by one
month’s notice in writing.

106 Covenants implied in leases

In every lease of land there shall be implied the following covenants by the
lessee, for himself, his executors, administrators, and assigns:
(a) That he or they will pay the rent thereby reserved at the time therein
mentioned:
Provided that in case the demised premises or any part of it shall at any time
during the continuance of the lease, without neglect or default of the lessee, be
destroyed or damaged by fire, flood, lightning, storm, tempest or earthquake so
as to render the same unfit for the occupation and use of the lessee, then and so
often as the same shall happen, the rent thereby reserved, or a proportionate part
of it, according to the nature and extent of the damage, shall abate, and all or any
remedies for the recovery of the rent or the proportionate part of it shall be
suspended until the demised premises shall have been rebuilt or made fit for the
occupation and use of the lessee, and in the case of any dispute arising under this
proviso the same shall be referred to arbitration under the Arbitration Act 1908:
(b) That he or they will, at all times during the continuance of the said
lease, keep, and at the termination of it, yield up, the demised
premises in good and tenantable repair, having regard to their
condition at the commencement of the said lease, accidents and
damage from fire, flood, lightning, storm, tempest, earthquake and
fair wear and tear (all without neglect or default of the lessee)
excepted.

107 Powers in lessor

In every lease of land there shall be implied the following powers in the
lessor, his executors, administrators, or assigns:
(a) That he or they may, by himself or themselves, or his or their agents,
at all reasonable times, enter upon the demised premises and view
the state of repair of it, and may serve upon the lessee, his executors,
administrators or assigns, a notice in writing of any defect, requiring
him or them, within a reasonable time, to be prescribed in it, to
repair the same under the covenant in that behalf contained or
implied in the lease;
(b) That whenever the rent reserved is in arrear he or they may levy
the same by distress;
(c) That whenever the rent or any part of it whether legally demanded
or not, is in arrear for the space of 1 month, or whenever the lessee
has failed to perform or observe any of the covenants, conditions
or stipulations contained or implied in the lease, and on the part of
the lessee to be performed or observed, he or they may re-enter the

Property Law Act 1952

1471
demised premises (or any part of it in the name of the whole) and thereby determine the estate of the lessee, his executors, administrators, or assigns in it, but without releasing him or them from liability in respect of the breach or non-observance of any such covenant, condition, or stipulation.

108 Effect of licence to assign

A condition or covenant not to assign or underlet or to do any other act
without licence shall not be released or determined by any such licence.

109 No fine for licence to assign

(1) In all leases containing a covenant, condition, or agreement that the
lessee shall not, without the licence or consent of the lessor, assign, underlet, part
with the possession, or dispose of the demised premises or any part of it, that
covenant, condition, or agreement shall, unless the lease contains an express
provision to the contrary, be deemed to be subject to a proviso to the effect that no
fine or sum of money in the nature of a fine shall be payable for or in respect of
any such licence or consent; but this proviso shall not preclude the right to require
the payment of a reasonable sum in respect of any legal or other expenses incurred
in relation to the licence or consent.
(2) Neither the assignment or underletting of any leasehold by the assignee
of a bankrupt, or by the liquidator of a company, or by the Sheriff under an
execution, nor the bequest of a leasehold, shall be deemed to be a breach of any
such covenant, condition or agreement, unless the contrary is expressly declared
in the lease.
(3) For the purposes of this section, terms defined in section 117 have the
meanings assigned to them by that section.

110 Licence or consent not to be unreasonably withheld

(1) In all leases, whether made before or after the commencement of this
Act, containing a covenant, condition, or agreement against assigning, underletting,
charging, or parting with the possession of demised premises or any part of it
without licence or consent, that covenant, condition, or agreement shall,
notwithstanding any express provision to the contrary, be deemed to be subject to
a proviso to the effect that the licence or consent is not to be unreasonably withheld,
but this proviso does not preclude the right of the landlord to require payment of
a reasonable sum in respect of any legal or other expenses incurred in connection
with any such licence or consent.
(1A) For the purposes of this section, a licence or consent shall be treated
as unreasonably withheld if it is withheld by reason only of the colour, race, or
ethnic or national origins of any person.
(2) In this section “lease” has the same meaning as in section 117.

111 Merger of reversion not to affect remedies

Where the reversion of land subject to a lease is merged in any remainder
or other reversion, or future estate, the person entitled to the estate into which the
reversion has merged and his executors or administrators, shall have the same
remedy for non-performance or non-observance of the conditions or covenants
expressed or implied in the lease as the person who would for the time being have
been entitled to the mesne reversion so merged would have had.
1472 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

112 Rent and benefit of lessee’s covenants to run with reversion

(1) Rent reserved by a lease, and the benefit of every covenant or provision
in it having reference to the subject-matter thereof, and on the lessee’s part to be
observed or performed, and every condition of re-entry and other condition in it,
shall be annexed and incident to and shall go with the reversionary estate in the
land or in any part of it immediately expectant on the term granted by the lease,
notwithstanding severance of that reversionary estate, and may be recovered,
received, enforced, and taken advantage of by the person entitled, subject to the
term, to the income of the whole or any part, as the case may require, of the land
leased. This subsection extends to a covenant to do some act relating to the land,
notwithstanding that the subject-matter may not be in existence when the covenant
is made.
(2) The benefit of every condition of re-entry or forfeiture for a breach of
any covenant or condition contained in a lease shall be capable of being enforced
and taken advantage of by the person entitled, subject to the term, to the income
of the whole or any part, as the case may require, of the land leased, although that
person became, by conveyance or otherwise, so entitled after the condition of re­
entry or forfeiture had become enforceable.
(3) This section shall not render enforceable any condition of re-entry or
other condition waived or released before that person became entitled as aforesaid.

113 Obligation of lessor’s covenants to run with reversion

The obligation of a covenant entered into by a lessor with reference to the
subject-matter of the lease shall, in so far as the lessor has power to bind the
reversionary estate immediately expectant on the term granted by the lease, be
annexed and incident to and shall go with that reversionary estate or the several
parts of it, notwithstanding severance of that reversionary estate, and may be
taken advantage of and enforced by the person in whom the term is vested by
conveyance, devolution in law, or otherwise; and, in so far as the lessor has power
to bind the person entitled to that reversionary estate, the obligation aforesaid
may be taken advantage of and enforced against any person so entitled.

114 Apportionment of conditions on severance

Notwithstanding the severance by conveyance, surrender, or otherwise of
the reversionary estate in any land comprised in a lease, and notwithstanding the
avoidance or cesser in any other manner of the term granted by a lease as to part
only of the land comprised therein, every condition or right of re-entry, and every
other condition in the lease, shall be apportioned and shall remain annexed to the
several parts of the reversionary estate so severed, and shall be in force with respect
to the term whereon each severed part is reversionary, or the term in any land that
has not been surrendered, or as to which the term has not been avoided or has not
otherwise ceased, in like manner as if the land comprised in each severed part, or
the land as to which the term remains subsisting, as the case may be, had been the
only land comprised in the lease.

115 Restriction on effect of waiver

Where any actual waiver of the benefit of any covenant or condition in any
lease on the part of any lessor or his executors, administrators or assigns is proved
to have taken place on or after 1 January 1906 in any one particular instance, that
actual waiver shall not be deemed to extend to any instance or any breach of
covenant or condition other than that to which the waiver specially relates, or to
be a general waiver of any such covenant or condition, unless an intention to that
effect appears.

Property Law Act 1952

1473

116 Executor not personally liable for covenants

An executor or administrator shall not be personally liable on any covenant
entered into by a testator or intestate as a lessee of land, any rule of law
notwithstanding.

117 Interpretation

Relief Against Forfeiture

For the purposes of sections 118 and 119 –
“bankruptcy” does not include the voluntary winding up of any solvent
company;
“lease” includes an original or derivative underlease, a grant securing a
rent by condition, and an agreement for a lease where the lessee has
become entitled to have his lease granted;
“lessee” includes an original or derivative underlessee, a grantee under
any such grant as aforesaid, a person entitled under an agreement as
aforesaid, and the executors, administrators, and assigns of a lessee;
“lessor” includes an original or derivative underlessor, a grantor as
aforesaid, a person bound to grant a lease under an agreement as
aforesaid, and the executors, administrators, and assigns of a lessor;
“underlease” includes an agreement for an underlease where the
underlessee has become entitled to have his underlease granted;
“underlessee” includes any person deriving title through or from an
underlessee.

118 Restrictions on and relief against forfeiture

(1) A right of re-entry or forfeiture under any proviso or stipulation in a
lease, for a breach of any covenant, condition, or agreement in the lease, shall not
be enforceable by action or otherwise unless and until the lessor serves on the
lessee a notice specifying the particular breach complained of, and, if the breach is
capable of remedy, requiring the lessee to remedy the breach, and in any case
requiring the lessee to make compensation in money for the breach, and the lessee
fails within a reasonable tie after it to remedy the breach, if it is capable of remedy,
and to make reasonable compensation therefor in money to the satisfaction of the
lessor.
(1A)(a) Where the lease in respect of which such a notice has been served on the lessee has been mortgaged and the lessor has actual notice of the name and address of the mortgagee, he shall forthwith after serving the notice on the lessee serve a copy of the notice on the mortgagee.
(b) Failure to comply with this subsection shall not of itself prevent the exercise by the lessor of any right of re-entry or forfeiture under any proviso or stipulation in the lease.
(2) Where a lessor is proceeding by action or otherwise to enforce such a right of re-entry or forfeiture, or has re-entered without action, the lessee may, in the lessor ’s action (if any), or in any action brought by himself, or by proceeding otherwise instituted, apply to the Court for relief; and the Court, having regard to the proceedings and conduct of the parties under the foregoing provisions of this section, and to all the circumstances of the case, may grant or refuse relief as it thinks fit; and in case of relief may grant the same on such terms (if any) as to costs, expenses, damages, compensation, penalty, or otherwise, including the granting of an injunction to restrain any like breach in the future, as the Court in the circumstances of each case thinks fit.
1474 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) Where any such relief as aforesaid is granted, the Court shall direct a minute or record of it to be made on the lease or otherwise.
(4) This section applies although the proviso or stipulation under which the right of re-entry or forfeiture accrues is inserted in the lease in pursuance of the directions of any Act.
(5) For the purposes of this section a lease limited to continue so long as
the lessee abstains from committing a breach of any covenant, condition, or
agreement shall be and take effect as a lease to continue for any longer term for
which it could subsist, but determinable by a proviso for re-entry on such a breach.
(6) This section does not extend to a condition for forfeiture on the taking
in execution of the lessee’s interest.
(7) Except in a case where the lessee is bankrupt this section shall not affect
the law relating to re-entry or forfeiture in case of non-payment of rent.
(8) This section shall have effect notwithstanding any stipulation to the
contrary.

119 Protection of underlessees on forfeiture of superior leases

Where a lessor is proceeding, by action or otherwise, to enforce a right of
re-entry or forfeiture under any covenant, proviso, or stipulation in a lease, the
Court may, on application by any person claiming as underlessee any estate or
interest in the property comprised in the lease, or any part of it either in the lessor ’s
action (if any) or in any action brought by that person for that purpose, make an
order vesting, for the whole term of the lease or any less term the property
comprised in the lease, or any part of it in any person entitled as underlessee to
any estate or interest in that property, upon such conditions as to execution of any
deed or other document, payment of rent, costs, expenses, damages, compensation,
the giving of security, or otherwise as the Court in the circumstances of each case
thinks fit; but in no case shall any such under lessee be entitled to require a lease
to be granted to him for any longer term than he had under his original underlease.

Relief Against Refusal to Grant Renewal

120 Relief of lessee against refusal or lessor to grant a renewal or to assure

the reversion

(1) In this section, “lease”, “lessee”, and “lessor” have the same meanings
as in section 117.
(2) This section applies to leases made and shall have effect with respect to
any lease notwithstanding any stipulation to the contrary and notwithstanding
the expiry of the term of the lease.
(3) Where –
(a) By any lease to which this section applies the lessor has covenanted
or agreed with the lessee that, subject to the performance or
fulfilment of certain covenants, conditions, or agreements by the
lessee, the lessor will –
(i) on the expiry of the lease grant to the lessee a renewal of the
lease or a new lease of the demised premises; or
(ii) whether upon the expiry of the lease or at any time previous to
it assure to the lessee that lessor ’s reversion expectant on the
lease; and
(b) The lessor has refused to grant that renewal or that new lease or to
assure that reversion, as the case may be, on the ground that the
lessee has failed to perform or fulfil the said covenants, conditions,
and agreements, or any of them –
the lessee may in any action or by proceeding otherwise instituted, apply to the
Court for relief.

Property Law Act 1952

1475
(4) The Court, having regard to all the circumstances of the case, may grant or refuse relief as it thinks fit, and in particular may decree, order, or adjudge –
(a) That the lessor shall grant to the lessee a renewal of his lease or a new lease, as the case may require; or
(b) That the lessor ’s covenant or agreement to assure the reversion ought to be specifically performed and carried into execution, and that the lessor shall execute such assurances as the Court thinks proper for that purpose –
on the same terms and conditions in all respects as if all the covenants, conditions,
and agreements aforesaid had been duly performed and fulfilled.
(5) The Court may grant relief on such terms, if any, as to costs, expenses,
damages, compensation, penalty, or otherwise as the Court in the circumstances
of each case thinks fit.
(6) Failure by the lessee to give to the lessor notice of his intention to require
or to accept a renewal of a lease or a new lease or an assurance of the lessor ’s
reversion, as the case may be, within the time or in the manner, if any, prescribed
by the original lease shall not limit the rights of the lessee or the powers of the
Court under this section.
(7) The fact that the lessor may have granted any estate or interest in the
demised land to any person other than the lessee, which estate or interest would
be defeated or prejudicially affected by the grant of relief to the lessee, shall not
affect the power of the Court under this section, but in any such case the Court
may, if it thinks just, grant relief to the lessee and cancel or postpone any such
estate or interest and may, if it thinks fit, assess damages or compensation to be
paid to that person in respect of the defeat of or prejudicial effect upon the estate
or interest. Any damages or compensation to be paid under this subsection shall
as the Court may determine be payable either by the lessor or by the lessee, or
partly by the lessor and partly by the lessee in proportions to be fixed by the
Court.

121 Limitation of time for application for relief

(1) Application for relief under section 120 may be made at any time within
3 months after the refusal of the lessor to grant a renewal of the lease or to grant a
new lease or to assure the reversion, as the case may be, has been first
communicated to the lessee.
(2) For the purposes of the subsection (1), communication to the lessee of
notice in writing of the lessor ’s intention to refuse at the appropriate time to grant
a renewal of a lease or to grant a new lease or to assure the reversion shall be
deemed to be equivalent to communication of his refusal to grant the renewal or
new lease or to assure the reversion, and in any case where notice of intention is
so given the period of limitation fixed by subsection (1) shall begin to run from
the date of the communication of the notice accordingly.
PART 9
EASEMENTS, RESTRICTIVE STIPULATIONS AND ENCROACHMENTS

122 Easement in gross permitted

An easement over land may be created without being attached or made
appurtenant to other land, and such an easement shall run with and bind the land
over which it is created, and all persons claiming title to that land by, through, or
under the person creating the easement; and the easement so created shall be to
all intents and purposes an incorporeal hereditament, and shall be assignable
accordingly.
1476 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

123 Access or use of light or air

Except as herein provided, no tenement shall become servient to any other
in respect of the access of either light or air, and no person shall have or acquire by
prescription, grant, or otherwise any claim or right to the access of light or air to
any land or building from or over the land of any other person.

124-126 [Repealed by 2004/270]

127 Power for Court to modify or extinguish easements and restrictive stipulations

(1) Where land is subject to an easement or to a restriction arising under covenant or otherwise as to the user of it, the Court may on the application of any person interested in the land, by order modify or wholly or partially extinguish the easement or restriction upon being satisfied –
(a) That by reason of any change in the user of any land to which the
easement or the benefit of the restriction is annexed, or in the
character of the neighbourhood or other circumstances of the case
which the Court may deem material, the easement or restriction
ought to be deemed obsolete, or that the continued existence of it
would impede the reasonable use of the land subject to the easement
or restriction without securing practical benefit to the persons
entitled to the easement or to the benefit of the restriction, or would,
unless modified, so impede any such user; or
(b) That the persons of full age and capacity for the time being or from
time to time entitled to the easement or to the benefit of the
restriction, whether in respect of estates in fee simple or any lesser
estates or interests in the land to which the easement or the benefit
of the restriction is annexed, have agreed to the easement or
restriction being modified or wholly or partially extinguished, or
by their acts or omissions may reasonably be considered to have
abandoned the easement wholly or in part; or
(c) That the proposed modification or extinguishment will not
substantially injure the persons entitled to the benefit of that
restriction.
(2) Where any proceedings by action or otherwise are instituted to enforce
an easement or restriction, or to enforce any rights arising out of a breach of any
restriction, any person against whom the proceedings are instituted may in those
proceedings apply to the Court for an order under the section.
(3) The Court may on the application of any person interested make an
order declaring whether or not in any particular case any land is affected by an
easement or restriction and the nature and extent of it, and whether the same is
enforceable, and, if so, by whom.
(4) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(5) An order under this section shall, when registered as in this section
provided, be binding on all persons, whether of full age or capacity or not, then
entitled or thereafter becoming entitled to the easement, or interested in enforcing
the restriction, and whether those persons are parties to the proceedings or have
been served with notice or not.
(6) –
(7) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(8) In the case of other land a memorandum of the order shall be endorsed
on such of the instruments of title as the Court directs.

Property Law Act 1952

1477

128 Commissioner may authorise entry for erecting or repairing buildings

(1) The owner of any land may at any time apply to a Commissioner for
an order authorising him, or any person authorised by him in writing on that
behalf, to enter upon any adjoining land for the purpose of erecting, repairing,
adding to, or painting the whole or any part of any building, wall, fence, or other
structure on the applicant’s land, and to do on the land so entered upon such
things as may reasonably be considered necessary for any such purpose as
aforesaid.
(2) On any such application the Commissioner may make such an order
as the Commissioner thinks fit, and may make such order subject to such terms
and conditions as are thought fit.

129 Power of Court to grant special relief in cases of encroachment

(1) Where any building on any land encroaches on any part of any adjoining
land (that part being referred to in this section as the piece of land encroached
upon), whether the building was erected by the owner of the first-mentioned land
(in this section referred to as the encroaching owner) or by any of his predecessors
in title, either the encroaching owner or the owner of the piece of land encroached
upon may apply to the Court, whether in any action or proceeding then pending
or in progress and relating to the piece of land encroached upon or by an originating
application, to make an order under this section in respect of that piece of land.
(2) If it is proved to the satisfaction of the Court that the encroachment
was not intentional and did not arise from gross negligence, or, where the building
was not erected by the encroaching owner, if in the opinion of the Court it is just
and equitable in the circumstances that relief should be granted to the encroaching
owner or any other person, the Court, without ordering the encroaching owner or
any other person to give up possession of the piece of land encroached upon or to
pay damages, and without granting an injunction, may make an order –
(a) Vesting in the encroaching owner or any other person any estate or
interest in the piece of land encroached upon; or
(b) Creating in favour of the encroaching owner or any other person
any easement over the piece of land encroached upon; or
(c) Giving the encroaching owner or any other person the right to retain
possession of the piece of land encroached upon.
(3) Where the Court makes any order under this section, the Court may, in
the order, declare any estate or interest so vested to be free from any mortgage or
other encumbrance affecting the piece of land encroached upon, or vary, to such
extent as it considers necessary in the circumstances, any mortgage, lease, or
contract affecting or relating to that piece of land.
(4) Any order under this section, or any provision of any such order, may
be made upon and subject to such terms and conditions as the Court thinks fit,
whether as to the payment by the encroaching owner or any other person of any
sum or sums of money, or the execution by the encroaching owner or any other
person of any mortgage, lease, easement, contract or other instrument, or otherwise.
(5) Every person having any estate or interest in the piece of land
encroached upon or in the adjoining land of the encroaching owner, or claiming
to be a party to or to be entitled to any benefit under any mortgage, lease, contract,
or easement affecting or relating to any such land, shall be entitled to apply for an
order under this section, or to be heard in relation to any application for or proposal
to make any order under this section. For the purposes of this subsection the Court
may, if in its opinion notice of the application or proposal should be given to any
such person as aforesaid, direct that such notice as it thinks fit shall be given to
that person by the encroaching owner or any other person.
1478 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

129A Relief in cases of mistake as to boundaries or identity of land

(1) Where any person who has or had an estate or interest in any piece of
land (in this section referred to as the original piece of land) has, while he had that
estate or interest, erected a building on any other piece of land (that other piece
together with any land reasonably required as curtilage and for access to the
building being in this section referred to as the piece of land wrongly built upon),
if the building has been so erected because of a mistake as to any boundary or as
to the identity of the original piece of land, that person, or any other person for
the time being in possession of the building or having an estate or interest in
either the original piece of land or the piece of land wrongly built upon, or any
other person mentioned in subsection (6) may apply to the Court, whether in any
action or proceeding then pending or in progress and relating to the piece of land
wrongly built upon or by an originating application, to make an order under this
section.
(2) If in the opinion of the Court it is just and equitable in the circumstances
that relief should be granted to the applicant or any other person, the Court may
make an order –
(a) Vesting that piece of land wrongly built upon in the person or
persons specified in the order;
(b) Allowing any person or persons specified in the order to remove
the building and any chattels and fixtures or any of them from the
piece of land wrongly built upon;
(c) Where it allows possession of the building to any person or persons
having an estate or interest in the piece of land wrongly built upon,
requiring all or any of the persons having an estate or interest in
that piece of land to pay compensation in respect of the building
and other improvements to the piece of land wrongly built upon to
such person or persons as the Court may specify;
(d) Giving the person who erected the building or any person or persons
claiming through him the right to possession of the piece of land
wrongly built upon for such period and on such terms and
conditions as the Court may specify.
(3) Where appropriate, the Court may make any such order without
ordering the applicant or any other person to give up possession of the piece of
land wrongly built upon, or to pay damages and without granting an injunction.
(4) Where the Court makes any order under this section, the Court may, in
the order, declare any estate or interest in the piece of land wrongly built upon to
be free from any mortgage, lease, easement, or other encumbrance affecting that
piece of land, or vary, to such extent as it considers necessary in the circumstances,
any mortgage, lease, easement, contract, or other instrument affecting or relating
to that piece of land.
(5) Any order under this section, or any provision of any such order, may
be made upon and subject to such terms and conditions as the Court thinks fit,
whether as to the payment by any person of any sum or sums of money, or the
execution by any person of any mortgage, lease, easement, contract, or other
instrument or otherwise.
(6) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(7) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(8) [Repealed 101/51/1971 (NZ)]
(9) Nothing in this section shall restrict the operation of section 129.

Property Law Act 1952

1479
PART 10
ASSIGNMENTS OF THINGS IN ACTION

130 Assignment of debts and things in action

(1) Any absolute assignment by writing under the hand of the assignor
(not purporting to be by way of charge only) of any debt or other legal or equitable
thing in action, of which express notice in writing has been given to the debtor,
trustee, or other person from whom the assignor would have been entitled to
receive or claim that debt or thing in action, shall be and be deemed to have been
effectual in law (subject to all equities that would have been entitled to priority
over the right of the assignee if this Act had not been passed) to pass and transfer
the legal or equitable right to that debt or thing in action from the date of the
notice, and all legal or equitable and other remedies for the same, and the power
to give a good discharge for the same, without the concurrence of the assignor.
(2) Where the debtor, trustee, or other person liable in respect of any such
debt or thing in action has had notice that the assignment is disputed by the
assignor or any one claiming under him, or that there are other opposing or
conflicting claims to that debt or thing in action, he shall be entitled, if he thinks
fit, to call upon the several persons making claim to it to interplead concerning
the same; or he may, if he thinks fit, pay the same into the Court, under and in
conformity with the provisions of the Acts for the relief of trustees.
PART 11
MARRIAGE SETTLEMENTS

131-132 [Repealed by 2004/270]

133 Sanction of Court to be obtained

(1) Every minor in contemplation of his marriage may, with the sanction
of the Court, given on the application of the minor or his guardian, make a valid
and binding settlement or contract for a settlement of all or any part of his property,
or property over which he has a power of appointment whether in possession,
reversion, remainder or expectancy.
(2) Every conveyance, appointment and assignment of any such property,
and every contract to make a conveyance of it, appointment, or assignment of it
executed by the minor with the sanction of the Court for the purpose of giving
relief to the settlement shall be as valid and effectual as if the minor were of full
age.
(3) Where there is no guardian the Court may require a guardian to be appointed, and may also require that any persons interested or appearing to be interested in the property be served with notice of the application to the Court for its sanction.
(4) Where any appointment under a power of appointment or any
disentailing assurance, has been executed under this section by any minor as tenant
in tail, and afterwards that minor dies under age, the appointment or disentailing
assurance shall thereupon become absolutely void.
(5) [Repealed]
(6) The authority conferred by this section shall not extend to powers of
which it is expressly declared that they shall not be exercised by a minor.
1480 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 12
POWERS OF ATTORNEY

134 Execution by attorney in his own name

(1) The donee of a power of attorney may execute or do any assurance
instrument, or thing in and with his own name and signature and his own seal
(where sealing is required) by the authority of the donor of the power; and every
assurance, instrument, and thing so executed and done shall be as effectual in law
to all intents as if it had been executed or done by the donee of the power in the
name and with the signature and seal of the donor of it.
(2) This section applies to powers of attorney created by instruments
executed either before or after the commencement of this Act.

135 Continuance until notice of death or revocation received

(1) Subject to any stipulation to the contrary contained in the instrument
creating a power of attorney, the power shall, so far as concerns any act or thing
done or suffered thereunder in good faith, operate and continue in force until
notice of the death of the donor of the power or until notice of other revocation of
it has been received by the donee of the power.
(2) Every act or thing within the scope of the power done or suffered in
good faith by the donee of the power after such death or other revocation as
aforesaid, and before notice of it has been received by him, shall be as effectual in
all respects as if that death or other revocation had not happened or been made.
(3) A statutory declaration by any such attorney to the effect that he has
not received any notice or information of the revocation of the power of attorney
by death or otherwise shall, if made immediately before or if made after any such
act as aforesaid, be taken to be conclusive proof of the no-revocation at the time
when the act was done or suffered in favour of all persons dealing with the donee
of the power in good faith and for valuable consideration without notice of the
said death or other revocation.
(4) Where the donee of the power is a corporation aggregate the statutory
declaration shall be sufficient if made by any director, manager, or secretary of the
corporation or by any officer of it discharging the functions usually appertaining
to any of those offices or by any officer of the corporation appointed for that purpose
either generally or in the particular instance by the board of directors, council, or
other governing body by resolution or otherwise, and if it is to the effect that to
the best of the declarant’s knowledge and belief neither the attorney nor any servant
or agent of the attorney has received any such notice or information as is mentioned
in subsection (3); and where the declaration contains a statement that the declarant
is a director, manager, or secretary of the corporation or is an officer of the
corporation discharging the functions usually appertaining to any of those offices
or is an officer of the corporation appointed for the purpose of making the
declaration, the statement shall be conclusive evidence in favour of the persons
mentioned in that subsection.
(5) This section applies to powers of attorney executed in or out of Niue.

136 Irrevocable power of attorney for value

Where a power of attorney given for valuable consideration (whether
executed in or out of Niue) is in the instrument creating the power expressed to be
irrevocable, then, in favour of a purchaser –
(a) The power shall not be revoked at any time, either by anything
done by the donor of the power without the concurrence of the
donee, or by the death, mental deficiency, or bankruptcy of the
donor; and

Property Law Act 1952

1481
(b) Any act done at any time by the donee of the power in pursuance of the power shall be as valid as if anything done by the donor without the concurrence of the donee, or the death, mental deficiency, or bankruptcy of the donor, had not been done or had not happened; and
(c) Neither the donee of the power nor the purchaser shall at any time
be prejudicially affected by notice of anything done by the donor
without the concurrence of the donee, or of the death, mental
deficiency, or bankruptcy of the donor.

137 Power of attorney made irrevocable for fixed time

Where a power of attorney (whether executed in or out of Niue, and whether
given for valuable consideration or not) is in the instrument creating the power
expressed to be irrevocable for a fixed time in it specified, not exceeding 1 year
from the date of the instrument, then, in favour of a purchaser —
(a) The power shall not be revoked for and during that fixed time, either
by anything done by the donor of the power without the
concurrence of the donee, or by the death, mental deficiency, or
bankruptcy of the donor; and
(b) Any act done within that fixed time by the donee of the power in
pursuance of the power shall be as valid as if anything done by the
donor without the concurrence of the donee, or the death, mental
deficiency, or bankruptcy of the donor had not been done or had
not happened; and
(c) Neither the donee of the power nor the purchaser shall at any time
be prejudicially affected by notice, either during or after that fixed
time, of anything done by the donor during that fixed time without
the concurrence of the donee, or of the death, mental deficiency, or
bankruptcy of the donor within that fixed time.

138 Conveyance under power of attorney from person not in Niue

No person shall be entitled to object to the execution or proposed execution
of conveyance solely on the ground that the execution is under a power of attorney
from a person not in Niue.

139 Application to corporations

The provisions of this Part apply with the necessary modifications with
respect to any power of attorney executed by any corporation to the same extent
as if the corporation were a person and the dissolution of the corporation (however
occurring) were the death of a person within the meaning of this Part.
PART 13
PARTITION OF LAND AND DIVISION OF CHATTELS

140 In action for partition Court may direct land to be sold

(1) Where in an action for partition the party or parties interested,
individually or collectively, to the extent of one moiety or upwards in the land to
which the action relates request the Court to direct a sale of the land and a
distribution of the proceeds, instead of a division of the land between or among
the parties interested, the Court shall, unless it sees good reason to the contrary,
direct a sale accordingly.
(2) The Court may on the request of any party interested, and
notwithstanding the dissent or disability of any other party, direct a sale in any
1482 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
case where it appears to the Court that, by reason of the nature of the land, or of the number of the parties interested or presumptively interested therein, or of the absence or disability of any of those parties, or of any other circumstance, a sale of the land would be for the benefit of the parties interested.
(3) The Court may also if it thinks fit, on the request of any party interested, direct that the land be sold, unless the other parties interested, or some of them, undertake to purchase the share of the party requesting a sale; and, on such an undertaking being given, may direct a valuation of the share of the party requesting a sale.
(4) On directing any such sale or valuation to be made, the Court may give also all necessary or proper consequential directions.
(5) (a) Any person may maintain such action as aforesaid against any one
or more of the parties interested without serving the other or others,
and it shall not be competent to any defendant in the action to object
for want of parties; and at the hearing of the cause the Court may
direct such inquiries as to the nature of the land and the persons
interested therein, and other matters, as it thinks necessary or proper,
with a view to an order for partition or sale being made on further
consideration.
(b) All persons who, if this Act had not been passed, would have been
necessary parties to the action shall be served with notice of the
decree or order on the hearing, and, after the notice, shall be bound
by the proceedings as if they had originally been parties to the action,
and shall be deemed parties to the action; and all such persons may
have liberty to attend the proceedings, and any such person may,
within a time limited by rules of Court, apply to the Court to add to
the decree or order.
(6) On any sale under this section the Court may allow any of the parties
interested in the land to bid at the sale, on such terms as the Court deems reasonable
as to non-payment of deposit, or as to setting off or accounting for the purchase
money or any part of it instead of paying the same, or as to any other matters.

141 Proceeds of sale, how applied

(1) All money received under any such sale may if the Court thinks fit be
paid to trustees appointed by the Court, and applied, as the Court directs –
(a) In the discharge of any encumbrance affecting the land directed to
be sold; and, subject to it
(b) In the payment of the residue to the parties interested.
(2) Where the Court so directs, the trustees (if any) may in their discretion
apply the money in manner aforesaid; and where no such direction is given any
party interested may apply to the Court for an order that the money be so applied.
(3) Until the money can be applied as aforesaid, it shall be invested in
such securities as the Court may approve, and the interest and dividends of it
shall be paid to the parties interested.

142 Costs in partition suits

In any action for partition the Court may make such order as it thinks just
respecting costs up to the time of the hearing.

143 Division of chattels

Where any chattels belong to persons jointly or in undivided shares, the
persons interested to the extent of a moiety or upwards may apply to the Court
for an order for division of the chattels or of any of them, according to a valuation
or otherwise, and the Court may make such order and give such consequential
directions as the Court thinks fit.

144 Interpretation

In this Part –

Property Law Act 1952

PART 14
APPORTIONMENT
1483
“annuities” includes salaries and pensions;
“dividends” includes (besides dividends strictly so called) all payments
made by the name of dividend bonus, or otherwise out of the revenue
of trading or other companies or corporations, divisible between all or
any of the members of it, whether those payments are usually made or
declared at any fixed time or otherwise; and all such divisible revenue
shall for the purposes of this section be deemed to have accrued by
equal daily increments during and within the period for or in respect
of which the payment of the same revenue is declared or expressed to
be made but “dividends” does not include payments in the nature of a
return or reimbursement of capital;
“rent” includes rents and all periodical payments or renderings in lieu of
or in the nature of rent.

145 Income apportionable in respect of time

All rents, annuities, dividends and other periodical payments in the nature
of income (whether reserved or made payable under an instrument in writing or
otherwise) shall, like interest on money lent, be considered as accruing from day
to day, and shall be apportionable in respect of time accordingly.

146 Time when apportioned part payable

The apportioned part of any such rent, annuity, dividend, or other payment
shall be payable or recoverable in the case of a continuing rent, annuity, or other
payment as soon as the entire portion of which the apportioned part forms part
becomes due and payable, and not before; and where the payment is determined
by re-entry, death, or otherwise, as soon as the next entire portion of the same
would have become payable if the same had not so determined, and not before.

147 Recovery of apportioned parts

(1) All persons and their respective executors, administrators, and assigns
and also the executors, administrators, and assigns respectively of persons whose
interests determined with their own death, shall have such or the same remedies,
legal and equitable, for recovering such apportioned parts as aforesaid when
payable (allowing for a proportionate part of all just allowance) as they respectively
would have had for recovering such entire portions as aforesaid if entitled to it
respectively.
(2) Where any person is liable to pay rent reserved out of or charged on
lands or other hereditaments of any tenure, that person and the said lands or
other hereditaments shall not be resorted to for any such apportioned part forming
part of an entire or continuing rent as aforesaid; but the entire or continuing rent,
including the apportioned part, shall be recovered and received by the person
who, if the rent had not been apportionable under this Part or otherwise, would
have been entitled to the entire or continuing rent; and the apportioned part shall
be recoverable from the last-mentioned person by the executors, administrators
or other parties entitled under this Part.
1484 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

148 Exceptions and application

(1) Nothing in this Part shall render apportionable any annual sums
payable under policies of assurance of any description.
(2) This Part does not extend to any case in which it is expressly stipulated
that apportionment shall not take place.

149 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 15
PART 16
RENTCHARGES AND OTHER ANNUAL SUMS

150 Recovery of annual sums charged on land

(1) Where a person is entitled to receive out of any land, or out of the income
of any land, any annual sum, payable half-yearly or otherwise, whether charged
on the land or on the income of the land, and whether by way of rentcharge or
otherwise, not being rent incident to a reversion, then, subject and without prejudice
to all estates, interests, and rights having priority to that annual sum, the person
entitled to receive the same shall have such remedies for recovering and compelling
payment of the same as are described in this section, so far as those remedies
might have been conferred by the instrument under which the annual sum is
payable, but not further.
(2) If at any time the annual sum, or any part of it, is unpaid for 21 days
next after the time appointed for any payment in respect of it, the person entitled
to receive the annual sum may enter into and distrain on the land charged or any
part of it, and dispose of it according to law of any distress found, to the intent
that thereby or otherwise the annual sum and all arrears of it, and all costs and
expenses occasioned by non-payment of it may be fully paid.
(3) If at any time the annual sum or any part of it is unpaid for 40 days
next after the time appointed for any payment in respect of it, then, although no
legal demand for that payment has been made, the person entitled to receive the
annual sum may enter into possession of and hold the land charged, or any part
of it and take the income of it until thereby or otherwise the annual sum, and all
arrears of it due at the time of his entry, or afterwards becoming due during his
continuance in possession, and all costs and expenses occasioned by non-payment
of the annual sum, are fully paid; and the possession when taken shall be without
impeachment of waste.
(4) In the like case the person entitled to the annual charge, whether taking
possession or not, may also by deed convey the land charged, or any part of it to
a trustee for a term of years, with or without impeachment of waste, on trust, by
mortgage, or sale, or demise for all or any part of the term, of the land charged, or
of any part of it, or by receipt of the income of it, or by all or any of those means,
or by any other reasonable means, to raise and pay the annual sum and all arrears
of it due or to become due, and all costs and expenses occasioned by non-payment
of the annual sum, or incurred in compelling or obtaining payment of it, or
otherwise relating to it, including the costs of the preparation and execution of the
deed of demise, and the cost of the execution of the trusts of that deed; and the
surplus, if any, of the money raised or of the income received under the trusts of
that deed shall be paid to the person for the time being entitled to the land therein
comprised in reversion immediately expectant on the term thereby created.
(5) This section applies only where the instrument under which the annual
sum is payable comes into operation on or after 1 January 1906, and then only in
so far as a contrary intention is not expressed in the instrument and shall have
effect, subject to the terms and provisions of it.

Property Law Act 1952

1485
(6) The rule of law relating to perpetuities shall not apply to any powers or remedies conferred by this section, nor to the same, or like powers or remedies conferred by any instrument for recovering or compelling the payment of any annual sum within the meaning of this section.

151 [Repealed by 2004/270]

152 Service of notices

PART 17
SERVICE OF NOTICES
(1) (a) Any notice required or authorised by this Act to be served on any person shall be delivered to that person, and may be delivered to him either personally or by posting it by registered letter addressed to that person at his last known place of abode or business in Niue.
(b) A notice so posted shall be deemed to have been served at the time
when the registered letter would in the ordinary course of post be
delivered.
(2) If the person is absent from Niue, the notice may be delivered as
aforesaid to his agent in Niue. If he is deceased, the notice may be delivered as
aforesaid to his personal representative.
(3) If the person is now known, or is absent from Niue and has no known
agent in Niue, or is deceased and has no personal representative, the notice shall
be delivered in such manner as may be directed by an order of the Court.
(4) Notwithstanding anything in subsections (1) to (3) the Court may in
any case make an order directing the manner in which any notice is to be delivered,
or dispensing with the delivery of it.
(5) This section does not apply to notices served in proceedings of the Court.

153 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 18
MISCELLANEOUS

154 Protection of solicitors and trustees

(1) It is hereby declared that the powers given by this Act to any person,
and the covenants, provisions, stipulations and words which under this Act are to
be deemed included or implied in any instrument, or are by this Act made
applicable to any contract for sale or other transaction, are and shall be deemed in
law proper powers, covenants, provisions, stipulations and words to be given by
or to be contained in any such instrument, or to be adopted in connection with or
applied to any such contract or transaction; and a solicitor shall not be deemed
guilty of neglect or breach of duty, or become in any way liable, by reason of his
omitting in good faith in any such instrument, or in connection with any such
contract or transaction, to negative the giving, inclusion, implication, or application
of any of those powers, covenants, provisions, stipulations, or words or to insert
or apply any others in place of it, in any case where the provisions of this Act
would allow of his doing so.
(2) But nothing in this Act shall be taken to imply that the insertion in any
such instrument, or the adoption in connection with, or the application to, any
contract or transaction of any further or other powers, covenants, provisions,
stipulations, or words is improper.

1486 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(3) Where the solicitor is acting for trustees, executors, or other persons in a fiduciary capacity, those persons shall also be protected in like manner.

(4) Where such persons as aforesaid are acting without a solicitor they shall also be protected in like manner.

155 [Spent]

1487

PUBLIC EMERGENCY ACT 1979

1979/51 – 31 January 1980

1

Short title

5

Protection of persons acting under

2

Issue of Proclamations of Emergency

authority of this Act

3

Emergency regulations

4

Special provisions applicable pending issue

of Proclamation of Emergency

To make provision for the protection of the community in cases of emergency

1 Short title

This is the Public Emergency Act 1979.

2 Issue of Proclamation of Emergency

(1) Cabinet may by Proclamation of Emergency declare that a state of
emergency exists throughout Niue or, throughout any area or areas that may be
specified in the Proclamation if any time it appears to Cabinet that –
(a) Certain action has been taken or is immediately threatened by any
person or body of persons of such a nature and on so extensive a
scale as to be calculated, by interfering with the supply and
distribution of food, water, fuel, or light or with the means of
locomotion, to deprive the community of the essentials of life; or
(b) Circumstances exist or are likely to come into existence, whereby
the public safety or public order is or is likely to be imperilled.
(2) No such Proclamation shall be in force for more than one month, without
prejudice to the issue of another Proclamation at or before the end of that period.
(3) Where a Proclamation of Emergency has been made, it shall be
communicated to the Assembly at its next meeting.

3 Emergency regulations

(1) Where a Proclamation of Emergency is in force, and so long as the
Proclamation is in force, Cabinet may make such regulations as it thinks necessary
for the following purposes –
(a) The prohibition of any acts which in its opinion would be injurious
to the public safety; and
(b) The conservation of public safety and order, and
(c) Securing the essentials of life to the community.
(2) Without limiting the generality of the authority conferred by subsection
(1), any regulations as aforesaid may confer or impose on a responsible Minister
or any Department of State, or on any persons in the service of the Crown or
acting on behalf of the Crown, such powers and duties as Cabinet deems necessary
for –
(a) The preservation of peace and order;
(b) Securing and regulating the supply and distribution of food, water,
fuel, light and other necessities;
1488 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(c) Maintaining the means of transit, transport or locomotion; and
(d) Any other purposes essential to the maintenance of public safety,
order and the life of the community.
(3) Cabinet may make such provisions incidental to the powers aforesaid
as may be required for making the exercise of those powers effective.
(4) Any regulations made under the authority of this section may apply
throughout Niue, notwithstanding that a Proclamation of Emergency may have
been issued only in respect of a limited area or of limited areas, or may, according
to the tenor of such regulations, apply only within the area or areas specified or
defined in the Proclamation of Emergency.
(5) Any regulations so made shall be laid before the Assembly as soon as
they are made, and shall not continue in force after the expiration of 14 days from
the time they are laid before the Assembly unless a resolution is passed by the
Assembly providing for their continuance.
(6) (a) Every person who commits, or attempts to commit any act with
intent to commit, or counsels, procures, aids, abets, or incites any
other person to commit, or conspires with any other person (whether
in Niue or elsewhere) to commit, any offence against any such
regulation shall be liable on conviction before the Court to
imprisonment for a term of 3 months or a fine of 2 penalty units or
both such imprisonment and fine, together with the forfeiture of
any goods or money in respect of which the offence has been
committed.
(b) In any prosecution for any such offence the Court may admit such
evidence as it thinks fit, whether such evidence would be admissible
in other proceedings or not.
(7) (a) The regulations so made shall have effect as if enacted, in this Act,
but may be added to, altered, or revoked by resolution of the
Assembly or by regulations made in the like manner and subject to
the like provisions as the originals.
(b) All regulations made under this section and not earlier revoked
shall expire on the expiration of the Proclamation of Emergency by
virtue of which they were made, but may be revived either in whole
or in part by any subsequent Proclamation of Emergency.
(8) The expiry or revocation of any regulations so made shall not be deemed
to have affected their previous operation or the validity of any action taken under
them or any penalty or punishment incurred in respect of any contravention or
failure to comply with them or any proceeding or remedy in respect of any such
punishment or penalty.
(9) No regulations under this Act shall be deemed invalid because they
deal with any matter already provided for by any Act or because of any repugnancy
to any such Act.
(10) Nothing in this Act or in any regulation under this Act shall be so
construed or shall so operate as to take away or restrict the liability of any person
for any offence punishable independently of this Act.

4 Special provisions applicable pending issue of Proclamation

(1) (a) In any case of public emergency, whether arising from earthquake,
fire, flood, public disorder, or otherwise howsoever, in which, owing
to the suddenness of the occurrence, the interruption of
communications, or any other cause, sections 1 to 3 cannot be put
into operation immediately, the senior officer of the Police present

Public Emergency Act 1979

1489
in the locality shall assume responsibility for the issuing of all orders and instructions necessary in his opinion for the preservation of life, the protection of property, and the maintenance of order.
(b) The authority conferred by this section shall cease on the issue of a
Proclamation of Emergency under section 2.
(2) Every person who obstructs or interferes with any constable or other
person in the execution of any orders or instructions given by or with the authority
of the senior officer of the Police as aforesaid commits an offence and shall be
liable to the same penalty as if he had committed an offence against regulations
made under the authority of section 3.

5 Protection of person acting under authority of this Act

No action, claim, or demand whatsoever shall be made or allowed by or in
favour of any officer or person acting in the execution or intended execution of this Act or of any regulations under it, for or in respect of any damage, loss or injury sustained or alleged to have been sustained by reason of anything done or purporting to be done under the authority of this Act or of regulations as aforesaid, save only in respect of reasonable compensation for any property used or taken for or on behalf of the Crown under any powers conferred by this Act or by regulations under this Act.

1490 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1491

PUBLIC HEALTH ACT 1965

1965/24 – 29 January 1965

24 Register

Registration

25 Procedure and certificate of registration

26 Fees

27 Cancellation of registration

28 Offences

Provisions Covering all Classes of Food Premises

29 Requirements of food premises

30 Medical examination

31 Cleanliness of persons handling food

Special Classes of Food Premises

32 Additional requirements

33 Bakehouses

34 Meat and fish

35 Ice cream, milk ices and milk

Miscellaneous Provisions

36 Special powers of Director

37 Unlawful handling of food

38 Sale of unwholesome provisions

39 Unlawful interference with food and food

premises

CARE OF SICK PERSONS OTHER THAN IN HOSPITAL

17 Duty to notify Director of persons in need

of care

18 Treatment by laymen restricted

19 Change of abode restricted

20 Number of persons in sick room restricted

21 Lighting of fire in sick room restricted

22 Offences

PART 7

SANITATION (BUILDINGS AND DWELLINGS)

40 Interpretation

41 Requirements of buildings

42 Offences (buildings)

43 Requirements of dwellings

44 Overcrowding of dwellings prohibited

45 Offences (dwellings)

46 Enforcement order (buildings and

dwellings)

47 Closing order (buildings and dwellings)

48 Demolition order (buildings and dwellings)

49 Closing orders and demolition orders to

apply to food premises

PART 6

MANUFACTURE AND SALE OF FOOD 50-53 [Repealed]

Preliminary

23 Interpretation

PART 8

1492 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 9

64

Language of public notice and notices

54-59

[Repealed]

65

Serving of notices and orders

66

Protection of persons acting

under

PART 10

authority of Act

METHYLATED SPIRIT

67

Compensation

60

Interpretation

68

Other Acts not affected

61

Offences

69

Offences (generan( �/p>

70

Penalties (generan( �/p>

PART 12

71

Laying poison

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

72

Storage of drugs

62

[Repealed]

73

[Spent]

63

Powers of High Court in respect of certain

74

Application of fees and fines

orders under this Act

1 Short title


PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Public Health Act 1965.

2 [Repealed]

3 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“approved” means approved by the Chief Medical Officer;
“Director” means the Director of Health and includes any Medical Officer
and other officer of the Department of Health performing duties under
this Act on behalf and under the authority of the Director of Health and
includes also any Inspector of Health appointed under section 7;
Provided that, when an Inspector of Health has been appointed for the
specific purposes of one Part, reference to the Director of Health in that
Part shall be taken as including reference to an Inspector so appointed
only;
“isolation station” means an isolation station appointed under section 9;
“notice” means a notice in writing signed by the person authorised to give
such notice and to be served as provided in section 65;
“Director of Works” means the officer for the time being in charge of the
Public Works Department.
(2) Terms defined in any Part of this Act have the meaning so defined for
the purposes of any other Part.
PART 2
ADMINISTRATION OF PUBLIC HEALTH

4 [Repealed by 2004/270]

5 Principal functions of Director

The principal functions of the Director under this Act shall be –
(a) To prevent, limit, and suppress infectious and other diseases;
(b) To institute and carry out investigations in respect of public health;
(c) Generally to take all such steps or, as the case may be, to advise the
Cabinet on taking such steps, as may be necessary to secure the
promotion and conservation of human health.

Public Health Act 1965

1493

6 Powers of Director and duty of Police to assist –

(1) The Director shall have –
(a) Power to enter at all reasonable times any dwelling, building, land
or any other premises or place and inspect the same and to execute
on it any works authorised under or on this Act;
(b) All powers conferred on him for the purposes of any Part as
specified in any such Part;
(c) All other powers necessary to carry out his duties and functions
under this Act.
(2) It shall be the duty of every constable to give the Director any assistance
which he may require in the exercise of his duties and functions under this Act
and, when requested by the Director so to do, to accompany him and to enter
with him any premises or place.

7 Appointment of Inspectors

There may be appointed such number of Inspectors of Health as may be
necessary for the administration and operation of this Act and any Inspector so
appointed may be known as “Inspector of Health” or as “Mosquito Control Officer”
or “Food Inspector”, as the case may be, or by any other name indicating the
specific purposes (if any) for which he was so appointed.
PART 3
QUARANTINE

8 Special functions of Director

The Director shall confer with and advise the Cabinet in the administration
and application of the sanitary measures permitted or prescribed, as the case may
be, by the International Sanitary Regulations.

9 Appointment of isolation stations

(1) Cabinet may by public notice appoint any institution, building, premises
or place to be an isolation station for the purposes of this Act, and any such
appointment may be permanent or for any period or extended period as
circumstances require.
(2) The boundaries of any isolation station so appointed shall be exactly
defined in the public notice and the site of the station shall be marked off
accordingly and clearly indicated by fences, hoardings, posters or in such other
ways as the Cabinet may direct.

10 Offences

Every person who trespasses on any isolation station may, in addition to
any penalty inflicted under this Act or the Niue Act 1966 be detained within the
isolation station under an order issued by the Director under section 14(1)(d).

11 Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 4
NOTIFIABLE INFECTIOUS DISEASES
“carrier” means any person having in his blood, or in his nose or throat, or in his excretions, or in his discharges, or in his secretions, the specific infectious agent of any notifiable disease though he may exhibit no other sign or symptom of that disease;
1494 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“contact” means any person who has been exposed to risk of infection by a notifiable disease, when the length of time since such exposure does not exceed, in the opinion of the Director, the period or incubation of that disease;
“drug” means and includes any drug or medicine used in the treatment, prevention, investigation, or alleviation of any disease, illness, or injury affecting human beings;
“notifiable disease” means –
(a) Tuberculosis, whether pulmonary, glandular or osseous or in any
other form, and in any stage of development or course of medical
treatment which, in the opinion of the Director is infectious;
(b) Leprosy in all known forms of that disease;
(c) Venereal diseases including syphilis, gonorrhea and soft sore;
(d) Any other infectious disease which Cabinet may declare on
publication by public notice to be a notifiable disease;
“suspected person” means any person suspected to be suffering from a
notifiable disease or to be a carrier or contact.

12 Duty to notify the Director

(1) Every person who has reason to believe that he is a suspected person
or that any other person, whether under his care and responsibility or not, is a
suspected person, shall without delay notify the Director.
(2) Every person who knowingly fails to notify the Director as provided in
subsection (1) commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

13 Procedure on notification

On being notified as aforesaid the Director shall forthwith issue instructions
for the medical examination of every suspected person and make arrangements
for the medical treatment of every person found to be suffering from any notifiable
disease or to be a carrier or contact and, where in his opinion necessary, for the
isolation of any such person or any suspected person, as hereinafter provided.

14 Special powers of Director and offences

(1) The Director shall have power –
(a) To order any person to undergo such medical examination as he
thinks fit and for that purpose to attend before him at such time
and place as he may appoint;
(b) To order any person to undergo such medical treatment in his home
or in the hospital as the Director may prescribe;
(c) To enter at all reasonable times any dwelling, building, land or any
other premises or place where he has reason to believe that a
suspected person may be and to conduct in it such investigation
and such medical examination or treatment as he deems necessary;
(d) To order any person to be admitted to and detained in such isolation
station as he may direct, for such period of time or such extended
period of time as he deems necessary.
(2) For the purposes of subsection (1), “person” means every person
suffering from a notifiable disease, every suspected person, and every person who,
in the opinion of the Director requires any observation, examination, or treatment
necessary for the control of notifiable diseases.

Public Health Act 1965

1495
(3) All orders issued by the Director under this section shall be in writing signed by him and any order of admission and detention issued under subsection (1)(d) shall, when delivered to the person named in it, be sufficient authority to that person and shall bind that person to receive and detain under the order, the person in respect of whom the order is made and not to discharge such person except on receipt of an order in writing to that effect signed by the Director.
(4) Any Medical Officer, Inspector, or constable may without any authority other than this section apprehend any person who attempts to evade detention or who leaves an isolation station without being discharged as provided in this section, and shall deliver or return, as the case may be, the person so apprehended to the officer in charge of the isolation station.
(5) Except to the extent to which any part of the isolation station may be
open to visits by the public, no person shall visit any person detained under this
section except with the written permission of the Director which may be given
either generally or for any particular case and subject to any condition which the
Director may think fit to impose, and every person found without such permission
or in contravention of any condition attached to such permission on the site of
any isolation station or visiting any person detained in it commits an offence and,
in addition to any penalty inflicted under section 70, may be detained within the
isolation station under an order under subsection (1)(d).
(6) Every person who fails to comply with any order made by the Director
under subsection (1) or who escapes or attempts to escape from any isolation
station, commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding
0.5 penalty units.

15 Infecting any person with venereal disease

Every person who knowingly infects any other person with a venereal
disease or knowingly does or permits or suffers any act likely to lead to the infection
of any other person with any such disease, commits an offence and shall be liable
on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not
exceeding 1 penalty unit.

16 Occupation of suspended or diseased person restricted

(1) Except with the written permission of the Director, no person who to
his own knowledge suffers from any notifiable disease or is a suspected person
shall engage, and no person shall knowingly employ any person so suffering or
being a suspected person in any of the following occupations, that is to say –
(a) The handling of food within the meanings of Part 6;
(b) Any trade, business, or occupation connected with the supply,
preparation or distribution of drugs or tobacco in any form;
(c) Laundry work;
(d) Tailoring;
(e) Domestic service;
(f) Nursing and midwifery;
(g) Hairdressing;
(h) Work in any store or shop;
(i) Driving any vehicle used for passenger services within the meaning
of Part 12 of the Transport Act 1965;
(j) Work on board any ship or vessel;
(k) Teaching or any other occupation involving close contact with
children.
1496 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) Every person who fails to comply with this section commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units in the case of an individual, and 2 penalty units in the case of a company or other body corporate as employer.
PART 5
CARE OF SICK PERSONS OTHER THAN IN HOSPITAL

17 Duty to notify Director of persons in need of care

Every person who has reason to believe that any other person, whether
under his care and responsibility or not, is by reason of age, infirmity, or disease,
living in a destitute or insanitary condition or without proper care or attention,
shall without delay notify the Director.

18 Treatment by laymen restricted

No person other than a Medical Officer or a nurse shall apply mechanical
restraint to any person of unsound mind without the previous consent in writing
of the Director.

19 Change of abode restricted

No person who is seriously ill shall be removed from any dwelling to any
other place (other than the hospital or any isolation station) without the previous
consent in writing of the Director.

20 Number of persons in sick room restricted

(1) Not more than 3 persons shall congregate in a sick room.
(2) Only persons in immediate attendance on a sick person shall sleep in
such sick person’s room and not more than 2 persons being so in attendance shall
sleep in that room at one and the same time.

21 Lighting of fire in sick room restricted

No fire shall be lighted in a sick room except in a properly constructed
fireplace with a chimney attached.

22 Offences

Any person who fails to comply with this Part commits an offence.

23 Interpretation

PART 6
MANUFACTURE AND SALE OF FOOD

Preliminary

(1) In this Part, and subject to subsection (2) –
“bakehouse” means any place in which are prepared or baked for sale for
human consumption bread, doughnuts, biscuits, cakes or confectionery,
and includes any portion of any such premises used for the storage of
yeast or flour or the kneading or working of dough;
“Certificate of Registration” includes every renewal of such certificate;
“engaging in the handling of food” means the handling of food as employer
or employee or in any capacity whatsoever, whether permanently or
temporarily and, if as employee, whether for remuneration or not;
“food” means every article used for food or drink by man other than drugs
and water, and includes flavouring matters and condiments as well as
every article used in the composition or preparation of food;

Public Health Act 1965

1497
“food premises” means and includes – (a) any bakehouse or cake-kitchen; (b) any meat room;
(c) any place used for the sale of meat or fish;
(d) any place used for the storage of retail sale of milk;
(e) any place used for the manufacture, packing, or sale of ice cream or
milk ices;
(f) any place used for the manufacture or bottling of cordials, syrups,
aerated waters, or beverages;
(g) any other premises or buildings or any room or other part of them
or any place in or on which food is handled;
“handling of food” means taking part in the manufacture, preparation,
storage, packing, carriage or delivery of food for sale, or in the retail
sale of food;
“meat” means the edible parts of any mammal, fish, fowl, crustacean, or
mollusc ordinarily used for human consumption and includes any food
containing meat;
“sell” includes to barter and also includes to offer or attempt to sell or
receive for sale or have in possession for sale or send forward for sale
or deliver for sale or cause or suffer or allow to be sold, offered or
exposed for sale, but refers only to selling for consumption or use by
man, and to sell food includes to supply meals at any restaurant, hotel
or boardinghouse;
“vehicle” has the same meaning as in the Transport Act 1965.
(2) Nothing in this Part shall be so construed as to apply to the growing
and harvesting of any kind of fruit, vegetable or seed and the transporting of the
same as harvested to any place for storage, sale, manufacture, or processing.

24 Register

Registration

The Director shall compile and keep at his office a record of all registered food premises and of all certificates of registration issued with respect to such premises and also of the fees received.

25 Procedure and certificate of registration

(1) Application for the registration of any food premises shall be made to
the Director and shall contain such particulars as the Director may in any individual
case require.
(2) On receipt of an application for registration of any class of food premises
the Director, if satisfied that the food premises comply with all the requirements
of this Part pertaining to that class of food premises, shall register the food premises
and issue to the applicant a certificate of registration for such period of time not
exceeding one year, as the Director thinks fit.
(3) Any such certificate may be renewed in the same manner on application
made on or before the date of its expiration.
(4) Any certificate of registration shall be posted conspicuously in the food
premises to which it relates and a fresh certificate shall be issued on every renewal
of registration.
1498 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

26 Fees

(1) Cabinet may by public notice prescribe that fees shall be payable for
the registration of any specified class or classes of food premises and shall
determine the amount of any fee so prescribed.
(2) Every application for registration shall be accompanied by the amount
of the fee (if any) so prescribed and determined.

27 Cancellation of registration

(1) The Director may by notice cancel and endorse any certificate of
registration and direct the holder of the certificate to discontinue the handling of
food in the food premises on and from a date specified in the notice, if he considers –
(a) That the certificate had been obtained by a substantially false
statement in the application; or
(b) That the food premises do no longer comply with all the relevant
requirements of this Part; or
(c) That the food premises are not kept as required by this Part or that
work is carried out or food handled in the food premises or in
connection with the business conducted in the food premises
contrary to the provisions of this Part.
(2) If the Director in the exercise of the powers conferred on him by
subsection (1) directs the holder of the certificate to discontinue the handling of
food he may make his direction known to the public in any way he thinks fit.
(3) Within 5 days of the receipt of such notice the holder of the certificate
may file with the Registrar of the Court an application for relief from the
requirements of the notice setting forth the extent and grounds of the relief sought.
(4) In hearing and determining any application so filed a Judge shall have
and may exercise all the powers which he has in his ordinary jurisdiction and his
determination shall be final.
(5) Pending the expiration of the time within which the application for
relief may be lodged and the determination of the motion the notice shall be deemed
to be suspended.
(6) On hearing the case the Judge may cancel the notice or may confirm it
either absolutely or subject to such conditions and modifications as he thinks just.
(7) The power to cancel any certificate of registration under this section
may be exercised in addition to any penalty which the holder of the certificate
may have incurred under this Act or any other enactment for the time being in
force.

28 Offences

Every person who engages in the handling of food in any food premises –
(a) Without first having obtained a certificate of registration with
respect to those particular food premises; or
(b) After the date of expiry of such certificate; or
(c) In the event of cancellation –
(i) If no application for relief is filed, on the expiration of 5 days
after receipt of the notice or after the date specified in the notice
whichever is the later;
(ii) If application for relief is duly filed, after the date on or from
which the notice is confirmed by an order of the Court,
commits an offence and, unless he is guilty of contempt of the High Court within
the meaning of section 101 of the Niue Act 1966 shall be liable on conviction to a
fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units in the case of an individual, and 2 penalty

Public Health Act 1965

1499
units in the case of a company or other body corporate and, if there is a continuing one, to a further fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day on which the offence has continued.

Provisions Covering all Classes of Food Premises

29 Requirements of food premises

(1) No food premises shall be opened in any building, premises, or other
places which are or have at any time been used for any purpose likely to affect injuriously the cleanliness of the food premises or the food handled in it.
(2) Buildings shall –
(a) Be well constructed, in good repair, weatherproof, and shall offer
no entrance or harbourage for rats, mice and other vermin;
(b) Have approved means of lighting and ventilation;
(c) Be provided with approved drainage:
Provided that no drain or pipe carrying off faecal matter or sewage
shall be approved if it has any opening within the food premises;
(d) When adjacent to any dwelling, be separated therefrom by an
approved solid wall.
(3) Floors shall be constructed of approved material suited to the process
of work carried out there, and properly graded and drained.
(4) The internal surfaces of all walls shall be finished with an approved
material having a smooth even surface capable of being readily cleaned and ceilings
shall be of approved design.
(5) All staircases or passages in any food premises or leading to them shall
be kept lime-washed or painted with not less than 2 coats of approved paint or
varnish.
(6) All food premises shall be provided with –
(a) Approved fly-proof cupboards or other receptacles for all the food
or other products of the food premises and with sufficient metal
receptacles for waste and refuse;
(b) Tables and benches suitable for handling food and having an
approved impervious surface free from cracks and capable of being
easily cleaned;
(c) An approved constant supply of clean water, basin, soap and hand
towels for the washing of hands of food handlers.
(7) No dust bin shall at any time be placed within any food premises, and
no food premises shall be in direct communication with any urinal, privy or water
closet, or situated less than fifty yards from any pigsty or from any domestic animal.
(8) No animal shall be kept or allowed to be in any food premises.
(9) (a) No room forming part of the food premises and being used for
their purposes shall serve during any period of the day or the night
as a sleeping-apartment or as a living-apartment.
(b) Any room forming part of the food premises without being used
for their purposes may serve as a sleeping-apartment or as a living-
apartment, but if it is situated on the same level with any room
used as food premises, only when effectually separated therefrom
by a partition extending from the floor to the ceiling and provided
with approved ventilation.
(10) All food premises shall be kept scrupulously clean and their grounds
kept tidy and free from any accumulation of rubbish or other matter likely to
harbour flies and other insects, rats, mice or other vermin.
1500 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(11) Food and every implement, article, utensil, tool of trade, bench, fitting, machine or other appliance, and every vehicle used for or in connection with the carriage or delivery of food shall at all times be kept clean and free from dust and foul odours and be protected as far as practicable against the access of flies and other insects, or of rats, mice and other vermin.
(12) All receptacles shall be emptied and cleaned at such intervals as may
be necessary to prevent a nuisance arising from their contents and shall be kept
covered except when being filled or emptied.

30 Medical examination

(1) (a) Every person engaged or taking up engagement in the handling of
food shall, before taking up such engagement, and once every year
thereafter or at such shorter intervals as the Director may direct,
present himself to the Director for a medical examination.
(b) The Director may exempt any person from compliance with the
requirements of this section when the nature of his engagement in
the handling of food obviates the necessity for such compliance.
(2) Every person, not being so exempted, who fails to comply with this
section commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding
0.5 penalty units.

31 Cleanliness of persons handling food

(1) Every person shall, while handling food maintain his clothing, his
hands, and his body clean and shall, before commencing work and every time
after visiting any privy and before resuming work, wash his hands thoroughly
with soap and clean water.
(2) No person who is, for the time being, suffering from any skin eruption
or who is wearing unclean or medicated bandages shall handle food.
(3) No person shall spit or smoke or chew tobacco while handling food.

Special Classes of Food Premises

32 Additional requirements

Without limiting in any way sections 29, 30 and 31 the following additional
provisions shall apply with respect to the specific classes of food premises described
hereinafter.

33 Bakehouses

(1) Every bakehouse shall comply in all respects with the requirements
hereinafter provided.
(2) The bakehouse shall be provided with a wooden or metal bench and
racks, troughs, bins and cupboards of approved design and material for the storage
of flour and all other articles of food or ingredients used in baking and all flour
and other food shall be placed on a table, bench, shelf, rack, or any other stand or
structure well above ground level.
(3) The bakehouse shall be used exclusively for the purpose of baking and
for the storage of flour and other articles of food or ingredients for baking and for
no other purpose.
(4) Every room or compartment in which flour is stored shall be free from
damp, and flour and other food shall as far as practicable be protected from dust,
vermin, and insects.

Public Health Act 1965

1501

34 Meat and fish

(1) All premises used for the preparation of meat or fish for sale and every
butcher ’s or fishmonger ’s shop for the retail sale of meat or fish and all work in
connection therewith shall comply in every respect with the requirements
hereinafter provided.
(2) The floor of any building so used shall be constructed of an approved
impervious material which shall be carried up the walls to a height of not less
than three inches in such a manner that angles between the floor and the walls are
concavely rounded off.
(3) All floors shall be thoroughly cleaned with hot water at least once every
working day and shall at all times be kept in a state of reasonable cleanliness.
(4) Tables, benches, shelves and all appliances with which meat or fish
may come into contact shall, as far as practicable, be impervious to water and
shall be kept clean.
(5) Every ventilation opening and every window shall be fitted with a
covering of wire gauze or other material suitable for excluding flies.
(6) If required by the Director, a self-closing door shall be fitted in every
doorway to such premises or shops so as to exclude flies.
(7) All meat and other articles of food except when being processed shall
be adequately protected by storage in a refrigerator or other approved
compartment or receptacle from contamination by dust, vermin, or insect.
(8) No bones or waste matter of any kind shall be kept longer than 12
hours in any such premises or shop.
(9) (a) No carcase or portion of a carcase shall, while being transported or
delivered to or from any such premises or shop, be deposited on
any roadway or wharf or on the deck of any vessel or on any similar
surface or place open to traffic, unless the carcase or portion of it,
as the case may be, is enclosed in a clean receptacle or cover;
(b) It shall not be necessary to cover any carcase or portion of a carcase
that is suspended during transit so that no part of it can rest on
such surface or place.
(10) No person shall transport any carcase or portion of a carcase in any
vehicle unless it is by any approved method protected from contamination caused
by coming into contact with any unclean portion of the vehicle.
(11) No person shall use for the carriage of meat any vehicle or receptacle
which is not so constructed as to be easily cleaned and capable of being kept so
closed or covered as to protect the meat being transported, from dust, flies and
other sources of contamination.

35 Ice cream, milk ices and milk

(1) All utensils used for the manufacture, packing, or sale of ice cream or
milk ices and all work in connection with it shall comply in every respect with the
requirements hereinafter provided.
(2) All appliances with which any ice cream or milk ice may come into
contact during its preparation, manufacture, or packing, shall be cleaned and
sterilised by steam, boiling water, or other approved method at least once each
working day.
(3) No person shall manufacture, store, or deposit any ice cream or milk
ice for sale, or store, or deposit the ingredients thereof or any milk in any vessel
which is not clean.
(4) No person shall use for transporting ice cream, milk ices, or milk any
vessel unless such vessel is so constructed as to permit of every part of its interior
1502 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
being seen and adequately cleaned, and unless it is provided with a lid or covering which protects the interior from dust, rain and contamination.
(5) Ice cream and milk ices for sale shall be kept in a separate compartment of a refrigerator or in a separate approved container within a refrigerator and any such compartment or container shall at all times be kept clean.
(6) No other kind of food or any other substance shall be placed or kept in
any compartment or container –
(a) Containing at the same time ice cream or milk ices, or
(b) Not containing any ice cream or milk ices for the time being, but to
be used again for containing the same.
(7) All dishes and servers used in the retail sale of ice cream and milk ices
shall be made of metal and shall have no moving parts and shall, when not in
actual use, be kept either in clear water or free from water in an approved covered
receptacle made of impervious material and capable of being easily cleaned and
sterilised.
(8) Ice cream, milk ices, and the cones or wafers or other containers in
which ice cream or milk ices are sold, shall at all times be protected from
contamination by dust and by flies and other insects.
(9) No person engaged in the manufacture, or packing, or in the sale of ice
cream or milk ices shall permit his hands or arms, or any part of his clothing, to
come into contact with any ice cream or milk ice.
(10) No person shall sell any ice cream or milk ice which, after having
been once frozen, has run down or melted and has again been frozen.

Miscellaneous Provisions

36 Special powers of Director

(1) The Director shall have power –
(a) To enter, inspect and examine at all reasonable times by day or night
any food premises or any vehicle used in connection with the
handling of food and to examine any food and any utensil used in
the handling of food;
(b) To make such examination or inquiry and to take such samples of
any food as he deems necessary for the control of compliance with
this Part;
(c) To seize any food that in his opinion is unfit for human consumption.
(2) On seizing any food the Director shall forthwith apply to the Court for
an order of forfeiture.
(3) (a) Without limiting section 69 and section 70 the Court on hearing the
application may make such order as it thinks just for the restoration
of any food seized or may order that the food shall be forfeited and
any such food shall be forfeited to the Crown accordingly and may
be disposed of in such manner as the Court directs.
(b) The Director may order any food seized to be destroyed prior to
the making of a Court order when the food is so decayed or putrified
that its restoration is not reasonably practicable.

37 Unlawful handling of food

Every person commits an offence who handles food in any food premises,
whether registered or not, which do not comply with all the relevant requirements
of this Part or who handles food in a manner contrary to the requirements of this
Part.

Public Health Act 1965

1503

38 Sale of unwholesome provisions

Every person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding one month or to a fine not exceeding 0.5
penalty units who sells, or exposes for sale, or has in his possession with intent to
sell, any food or drink which he knows or might by the exercise of reasonable care
have known to be unwholesome.

39 Unlawful interference with food and food premises

Every person not being a person engaged in the handling of food, who –
(a) Interferes without lawful excuse with any food or the handling of
it or with any thing or matter used in the handling of food so as to
prevent any provisions of this Part from being complied with;
(b) Who urinates, spits, smokes or chews tobacco in any food premises,
commits an offence.

40 Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 7
SANITATION (BUILDINGS AND DWELLINGS)
“building” means public buildings and business buildings; “business building” means and includes –
(a) Every shop, workshop, warehouse, store and other place in which goods are kept or exposed or offered for sale to dealers therein or to the public;
(b) Every office or place in which business of any description is transacted and to which the public have access for that purpose;
but, subject to section 49 does not include food premises within the
meaning of Part 6;
“dwelling” means any structure, whether permanent or temporary, used
for human habitation and includes any cookhouse belonging to the
dwelling;
“public building” means –
(a) Every building used as an assembly room or used for the purpose
of public worship or public meetings;
(b) Every building provided for the instruction, training, or use of the
pupils of any school.

41 Requirements of buildings

Every building shall comply to the satisfaction of the Director with the
following requirements –
(a) Every room in any building shall be provided with means of
ventilation so as to admit of a sufficient supply of fresh air and
carry off and render harmless, as far as practicable, all fumes, gases,
vapours, dust and other impurities arising from the use of the
building;
(b) Every room in any building shall be lighted to the extent that the
Director considers necessary for the purpose for which such room
is used;
(c) Every part of any building shall be day by day kept in a clean state
so as not to be injurious to health;
(d) Every building and land belonging to such building shall be kept
free from any leakage in any drain or sanitary convenience and
1504 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
from any other nuisance which is offensive or likely to be injurious to health;
(e) All land, sheds, and other outbuildings belonging to any building shall be kept in a state of reasonable cleanliness and refuse and rubbish shall be disposed of from time to time as circumstances require.

42 Offences (buildings)

(1) Every person who is responsible for compliance with section 41
(whether by law or by contract and whether by reason of his trade, occupation,
office or employment) and who makes default in such compliance commits an
offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units
and, if the offence is a continuing one, to a further fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty
units for every day on which the offence has continued.
(2) Every person who does any act or thing likely to impair or lower the
state of sanitary condition in any building commits an offence.

43 Requirements of dwellings

Every dwelling shall comply to the satisfaction of the Director with the
following requirements –
(a) The dwelling shall be provided with sufficient ventilation and
approved natural lighting;
(b) The dwelling including its movable contents shall be kept
reasonably clean. All bedding and mats shall be regularly aired and
gravel or leaf floors shall be renewed as circumstances require;
(c) The dwelling shall be provided with a properly built and maintained
latrine. Pit latrines shall be placed not less than twenty feet from
any dwelling, building, or public place.
Water seal latrines and septic tanks shall be placed not less than 10
feet from any dwelling, building or public place. Every latrine shall
be kept thoroughly clean at all times;
(d) Any enclosure for animals or birds belonging to the dwelling shall
be placed not less than 66 feet from the dwelling and shall be
properly kept and maintained;
(e) Every dwelling and land belonging to such dwelling shall be kept
free from any leakage in any drain or sanitary convenience and
from any other nuisance which is offensive or likely to be injurious
to health;
(f) All land, sheds, and other outbuildings belonging to the dwelling
shall be kept in a state of reasonable cleanliness and refuse and
rubbish shall be disposed of as circumstances require.

44 Overcrowding of dwellings prohibited

The Director may by notice limit the number of persons who may sleep in
one and the same room of any particular dwelling and for the purposes of this
Part every dwelling shall be deemed to be overcrowded if the number of persons
sleeping at the same time in any room exceeds the maximum number specified in
the notice.

Public Health Act 1965

1505

45 Offences (dwellings)

(1) Every person who uses or permits to be used any dwelling shall be
responsible for compliance with this Part relating to dwellings and every person
who uses or permits to be used any dwelling which does not comply with the
requirements of section 43 or which is overcrowded commits an offence and, on
conviction as provided in this section, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5
penalty units.
(2) Except as provided in subsection (3) on the hearing of any information
laid against any such person under this section, a Judge after hearing the evidence
shall, if the evidence supports the information, make an order directing the offender
to comply with every provision in respect of which default has been made, within
a time specified in the order and shall adjourn the hearing until some day after
the time so specified and on such adjourned hearing shall not convict the offender
unless he has wilfully failed to comply with the order made on the first hearing.
(3) If at any hearing of the information it is made to appear to the
satisfaction of the Judge that the neglect or omission in respect of which the
information is laid, was due to the physical incapacity of the offender or that
compliance with any requirements of section 43 or section 44 is liable to involve
undue hardship to the offender, the Judge may grant to the offender such
exemption from the requirements of those sections or, as the case may be, such
extension of time for compliance with them as, having regard to all the
circumstances of the case, appears just and reasonable and any such exemption or
extension may be so granted subject to any condition which the Judge deems fit
to impose.

46 Enforcement order (buildings and dwellings)

In every case where –
(a) Default is made in complying with any requirements of section 41
or section 43; and
(b) The person responsible for so complying has departed from Niue
without appointing any attorney, agent, or trustee to act in his stead
in respect of his duties and liabilities under those sections,
the Judge, on application made by the Director, may make an order (an enforcement
order) directing the Director of Works to enter upon the land and the dwelling or
building, as the case may be, and, at the expense in all things of the responsible
person, to carry out such work required by those sections and specified in the
order as appears necessary in the interest of the community, and the amount of all
such expenses shall be recoverable from that person as a debt due to the Crown.

47 Closing order (buildings and dwellings)

(1) If any building or dwelling is, by reason of its state of disrepair or for
any other reason likely to be injurious to health, a Judge of the Court, on application
made by the Director may, after hearing such evidence as he deems fit, make an
order (a closing order) prohibiting the use or occupation of the dwelling or building
or any part of it as the case may be, until the repairs, alterations, or other works
specified in the closing order have been carried out by the person or persons named
in the order to the satisfaction of the Director.
(2) The Judge shall, in the closing order, state the date on or before which
the works specified in the order shall be carried out and shall adjourn the hearing
until some day as soon as practicable after the time so specified.
1506 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) On such adjourned hearing –
(a) If a certificate issued by the Director is produced to the effect that
the works specified in the closing order have been carried out to
his satisfaction the Judge shall revoke the closing order;
(b) If no such certificate is produced the Judge may extend the time
specified in the closing order and adjourn the hearing accordingly
or make an order directing the Director of Works to enter upon the
land and the dwelling or building, as the case may be, and, at the
expense in all things of the person or persons named in the closing
order to carry out the works specified in the closing order and the
amount of all such expenses shall be recoverable from that person
or those persons as a debt due to the Crown.
(4) In any order made under subsection (3) (b) the Judge shall declare that
the closing order shall cease to have any force and effect on the issue of a certificate
signed by the Director of Works that he has carried out the works specified in the
closing order.
(5) The certificate so issued shall be handed over to the person or persons
named in the closing order and a copy shall be filed with the Registrar of the
Court.

48 Demolition order (buildings and dwellings)

(1) If any dwelling or part of it is permanently unfit for human habitation
or any building or part of it is permanently unfit for use or occupation, a Judge,
on application made by the Director, may, after hearing such evidence as he deems
fit, make an order (a demolition order) prohibiting the use or occupation of the
dwelling or building or any part of it, as the case may be, and requiring the person
or persons named in the order to take down and remove any structure specified
in the order to the satisfaction of the Director.
(2) The Judge shall, in the demolition order, state the date on or before
which the works specified in the order shall be carried out and shall adjourn the
hearing until some day after the time so specified.
(3) On such adjourned hearing –
(a) If a certificate issued by the Director is produced to the effect that
the works specified in the demolition order have been carried out
to his satisfaction, the Judge shall dismiss the case;
(b) If no such certificate is produced the provisions of section 47 (3) (b)
shall apply with all necessary modifications.
(4) On completing the works as directed the Director of Works shall file
with the Registrar of the Court a statement to the effect that the works have been
so completed.
(5) The provisions of this section shall, with all necessary modifications,
apply to the removal and destruction of any mat or other household article or of
any business utensil.
(6) If any building or dwelling described in subsection (1) is deserted or if
for any other reason no order under that subsection can be made, the Judge, on
application made by the Director may, after hearing such evidence as he deems
fit, make an order directing the Director of Works to enter and to demolish as
provided in subsection (4) (b) and such provisions of this section as are applicable
shall then apply with all necessary modifications.

49 Closing orders and demolition orders to apply to food premises

Notwithstanding section 40, section 47 and section 48 shall apply to all
classes of building including food premises within the meaning of Part 6.

Public Health Act 1965

1507

50-53 [Repealed by 10/63/1980]

PART 8

54-59 [Repealed by 1996/209]

PART 9

60 Interpretation

In this Part –
PART 10
METHYLATED SPIRIT
“methylated spirit” means any spirit which has been mixed with methyl- alcohol or with wood spirit, or to which any other substance has been added that has the like effect as methyl-alcohol or wood spirit in rendering such spirit unsuitable for human consumption and includes any spirit from which methyl-alcohol, wood spirit or such other substances has been unlawfully removed;
“spirit” means and includes alcohol and every other description of spiritous liquor.

61 Offences

Every person who consumes or attempts to consume or supplies to any
other person for the purpose of consumption methylated spirit, whether such
spirit has been subjected to any process of purification or not, and whether alone
or in solution with any other liquid, or who has any such methylated spirit or
solution containing methylated spirit in his possession for the purposes of
consumption by himself or by any other person, commits an offence and shall be
liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months.
PART 11
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

62 [Repealed by 2004/270]

63 Powers of High Court in respect of certain orders under this Act

(1) In hearing and determining any application made by the Director for
any enforcement order or for a closing order or a demolition order under this Act,
a Judge shall have and may exercise all the powers which he has in his ordinary
jurisdiction and his determination shall be final.
(2) The power to make any of the orders mentioned in subsection (1) may
be exercised in addition to any penalty inflicted on any person for non-compliance
with this Act or any other enactment for the time being in force.

64 Language of public notice and notices

(1) Every public notice given under this Act shall be in both the English
and Niuean languages.
(2) All other notices, orders, forms, or other documents used for the
purposes of this Act shall be in the English or Niuean language, or in both languages
as circumstances require.
1508 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

65 Serving of notices and orders

Where any notice has to be given or any order to be issued under this Act
such notice or order may be served either by delivering the same personally to the
person on whom it is to be served or by leaving the same at his usual place of
abode or by posting the same either by ordinary letter or, where it is necessary or
desirable that proof of the date of receipt be ensured, by registered letter, addressed
to him at his usual place of abode or, as circumstances require, by affixing the
same in some conspicuous place on the land to which it relates.

66 Protection of persons acting under authority of Act

No person who, while exercising any powers conferred on him by this Act,
in good faith does or orders or causes to be done any act in pursuance or intended
pursuance of any of the provisions of this Act shall be under any civil or criminal
liability in respect of that.

67 Compensation

(1) No person injuriously affected by any act done in the exercise of any
powers conferred by this Act shall be entitled to compensation.
(2) No person injuriously affected by the total or partial destruction of any
building, dwelling, or thing under a demolition order under section 48 shall be
entitled to compensation, if such destruction was necessary by reason of any default
made in complying with this Act.
(3) If such destruction was necessary in the interest of public health and
without any default so made, any person injuriously affected by it, shall be entitled
to compensation from the Crown for any loss which he may have suffered as a
result of such destruction.
(4) Any compensation claimed under subsection (3) shall be assessed and
awarded by the Court and no compensation shall be assessed in excess of the
actual market value of the building, dwelling (or part of it) or thing in respect of
which the claim is made.
(5) In hearing and determining any claim for compensation a Judge shall
have and may exercise all the powers which he has in his ordinary jurisdiction
and his determination shall be final.
(6) Any compensation awarded to any person under this section shall
constitute a debt due to him by the Crown and shall be payable out of the
appropriate account of the public revenues of Niue.

68 Other Acts not affected

Nothing in this Act shall be so construed as to limit or derogate from the
provisions of any other Act providing for building permits or for minimum
requirements and the control of dwellings or buildings in respect of construction,
sanitation, maintenance, repair or in any other respect.

69 Offences (generan( �/p>

Every person commits an offence who –
(a) Fails to comply with any order, notice or direction given to him by
the Director under this Act;
(b) Wilfully obstructs, hinders, or resists the Director of Works or any
other person in the execution of any power conferred on either of
those officers or that person by this Act;
(c) Offends against or fails to comply with any condition, duty, or
obligation imposed on him by this Act;

Public Health Act 1965

1509
(d) Does or omits, or causes or knowingly permits or suffers to be done or omitted, any act, matter or thing contrary to this Act;
(e) Knowingly makes a substantially false statement in any application or in connection with any information which he may be required to furnish under this Act.

70 Penalties (generan( �/p>

Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no penalty
is otherwise provided in this Act or in the Niue Act 1966, is liable to a fine not
exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

71 Laying poison

Every person is liable to a fine of 0.5 penalty units who without lawful
justification places any poison in any place so as to be a source of danger to human
beings or to animals.

72 Storage of drugs

(1) For the purposes of this section, the term “drug” (as defined in section
11) includes –
(a) Soaps and dusting powders; and
(b) Disinfectants, germicides, antiseptics, and preservatives used for
any purposes.
(2) Every person who has in his store or possession any drug for sale shall
store it in such a manner that the container is protected from damage and shall do
all things reasonably necessary to ensure that the contents are protected from
deterioration.
(3) Every person commits an offence who knowingly sells or offers for
sale any drug which has so deteriorated as to be harmful or dangerous to health.
(4) The provisions of section 36 shall apply with all necessary modifications.
(5) The Director may seize any drug which is or appears to be
unwholesome, unclean, damaged, deteriorated, perished, or injurious to health,
or which contains any decomposed organic substance.
(6) On seizing any drug as aforesaid the Director shall forthwith apply to
the Court for an order of forfeiture.
(7) Without limiting the provisions of section 69 and section 70 the Court
on hearing the application, may make such order as it thinks just for the restoration
of any drug seized or may order that the drug shall be forfeited and any such
drug shall be forfeited to the Crown accordingly and may be disposed of in such
manner as the Court directs.

73 [Spent]

74 Application of fees and fines

All fees, fines and other moneys received under this Act shall form part of
the public revenues of Niue and shall be paid into the appropriate account.

1510 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1511

PUBLIC NOTARIES ACT 1998

1998/236 – 28 March 1994

satisfied that the person –
(a) Is of good fame and character; and
(b) Is competent to act as a public notary.
(2) A person holds the office of public notary at the pleasure of Cabinet.

4 Roll of public notaries

(1) The Clerk to the Cabinet must maintain a roll of public notaries and
enter on it the name of each person who for the time being holds the office of
public notary.
(2) The Clerk to the Cabinet must make the roll of public notaries available
for inspection by any person during normal office hours.

5 Offence

A person –
(a) Who performs in Niue any act, matter or thing pertaining to the
office, function or practice of a public notary; and
(b) Whose name is not on the roll of public notaries,
is guilty of an offence and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty
units.

6 [Spent]

1512 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1513

PUBLIC REVENUES ACT 1959

1959/1 – 1 October 1959

1 Short title

2 Interpretation

PART 1

PART 6

OFFENCES

26 False declarations

27 Neglect to pay money into account

THE TREASURY

3 Administration of Act

4 Appointment of Financial Secretary

5 Financial Secretary may delegate

6 Accounting officers

7 Financial Secretary to be member of boards

PART 2

NIUE GOVERNMENT ACCOUNT

8 Public money to be kept in Government

Account

9 Government Account

10 Power of investment

11 Money collected for private persons

12 Deposits and trust money

13 Unclaimed deposits and trust money

PART 3

APPROPRIATION OF PUBLIC MONEY

14-18 [Repealed]

24A Rounding off transactions

PART 5

ANNUAL ACCOUNTS

25 Financial Secretary to furnish

28 Failure to appear for examination or

produce accounts

29 General penalty

30 Fines recoverable

PART 7

GENERAL PROVISIONS

31-31A [Repealed]

32 Succession in case of death or bankruptcy

33 [Repealed]

34 Recovery of money not accounted for

35 Financial Secretary’s instructions

36 Regulations and rules

37 Irrecoverable losses

38 Public stores

PART 8

PUBLIC SECURITIES

39 Custodians

40 Annual statement of investments

41 Taking and release of securities to the

Crown

42 Expenditure for protection of public

securities

PART 9

SURCHARGES

43 Meaning of a “deficiency or loss”

44 Deficiency or loss of public money or public

stores

45 Surcharge

46 Appeal to High Court

47 Set-off


1514 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

To make provision for the control of public moneys and public securities of Niue

1 Short title

This is the Public Revenues Act 1959.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“accounting officer” means any person who by any enactment, or
appointment is required to render any account, or who is charged with
the duty of collecting or receiving, or who does actually collect or
receive, any public money, or who is charged with the duty of
disbursing, or who does actually disburse, any public money, or who
is charged with the receipt, custody or disposal of or the accounting
for public stores or other public property;
“imprestee” means a person in whose hands any public money is placed
for expenditure in the public service;
“public money” means money or securities of any kind for the payment of
money, received for or on account of, or payable, or belonging to, or
deposited with the Government or any Department or agency of the
Government, and includes public securities;
“public securities” means securities representing the investment of any
public moneys;
“public stores” means chattels, machinery, livestock, or buildings in the
possession of or under the control of any person or department on
account of the Government.

3 Administration of Act

PART 1
THE TREASURY
Subject to the direction of Cabinet, the Financial Secretary shall be charged with the administration of this Act.

4 Appointment of Financial Secretary

On the occurrence from any cause of a vacancy in the office of Financial
Secretary (whether by reason of death, resignation, or otherwise) and in the case
of absence from duty of the Financial Secretary (from whatever cause arising)
and so long as any such vacancy or absence continues, the Public Service
Commission may appoint an officer of the public service to act as Financial
Secretary and such officer shall have and may exercise all the powers, duties and
functions of the Financial Secretary and the fact that he exercises such powers,
duties and functions shall be conclusive evidence of his authority to do so.

5 Financial Secretary may delegate

(1) The Financial Secretary may in writing either generally or particularly,
delegate to such officer or officers of the Treasury as he thinks fit all or any of the
power exercisable by him under this or any other Act, but not including this present
power of delegation.
(2) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions attached
by the Financial Secretary, the officer to whom any powers are delegated under
this section may exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same
effect as if they had been conferred upon him directly by this section and not by
delegation.

Public Revenues Act 1959

1515
(3) Any person purporting to act under any delegation under this section shall be presumed to be acting in accordance with the terms of the delegation in the absence of proof to the contrary.
(4) Any delegation under this section may be made to a specified officer or to officers of a specified class, or may be made to the holder or holders for the time being of a specified office or class of offices.
(5) Every delegation under this section shall be revocable at will and no such delegation shall prevent the exercise of any power by the Financial Secretary. (6) Every such delegation shall, until revoked, continue in force according
to its tenor, notwithstanding the fact that the Financial Secretary by whom it was made may have ceased to hold office, and shall continue to have effect as if made by the successor in office of that Financial Secretary.

6 Accounting officers

(1) The Financial Secretary by writing under his hand, either generally or
particularly authorise any accounting officer stationed within or outside Niue to
receive any public moneys, and to give any receipts or acknowledgements in
respect of any such money and to endorse any cheque, draft, bill or other negotiable
instrument received in respect of such money.
(2) Any accounting officer receiving any money under any authority
conferred upon him by the Financial Secretary shall pay the money into such bank
or to the credit of such account as the Financial Secretary directs.
(3) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions attached
by the Financial Secretary, an accounting officer on whom authority is conferred
under this section may exercise that authority in the same manner and with the
same effect as if it had been conferred on him directly by this section and not by
delegation.
(4) Every person purporting to act under any authority under this section
shall be presumed to be acting under the terms of the authority in the absence of
proof to the contrary.
(5) Any authority under this section may be given to a specified officer or
to officers of a specified class, or may be given to the holder or holders for the time
being of a specified office or class of offices.
(6) Every authority given under this section shall be revoked at will, and
no such authority shall prevent the exercise of any power by the Financial Secretary.
(7) Every such authority shall, until revoked, continue in force according
to its tenor, notwithstanding the fact that the Financial Secretary by whom it was
given may have ceased to hold office, and shall continue to have effect as if made
by the successor in office of that Financial Secretary.

7 Financial Secretary to be member of boards

(1) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in any other Act, the Financial
Secretary shall be deemed to be a member of any board or other body of which
Cabinet directs the Financial Secretary shall be a member, being a board or other
body charged with the control of investment of public money or of any other
money administered by any department of the Government.
(2) In the absence of the Financial Secretary from any meeting of any such
board or other body, he may authorise any other officer of the Treasury to attend
the meeting in his stead. The fact that any other officer of the Treasury attends and
acts as a member of any board at any meeting shall be conclusive proof of his
authority to do so.
1516 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 2
NIUE GOVERNMENT ACCOUNT

8 Public money is to be kept in Government Account

(1) All public money is the property of Government and shall, except as
herein otherwise provided, be kept in one account called the Niue Government
Account.
(2) The Financial Secretary may authorise the payment of any public money
to a bank account either by way of fixed deposit or current account.
(3) All money paid into the Niue Government Account or into any bank
account shall be deemed to be public money, the property of Her Majesty, or to be
money lent by Her Majesty to the Bank, and may not be removed from it except as
provided in this Act.

9 Government Account

The Niue Government Account shall consist of –
(a) The Appropriation Account comprising the accounts of all
departments of the Government to which shall be carried the
revenues of Niue;
(b) Every separate fund, account, or subsidiary account which by any
Act, or regulation is directed to form part of the Niue Government
Account or which, after notice to the Audit Office, the Financial
Secretary may open and keep with intent to make better provision
for accounting for money in the Niue Government Account.

10 Power of investment

(1) The Financial Secretary may invest or cause to be invested any balance
of the Niue Government Account, or any part of it, and may sell and convert or
cause to be sold and converted into money, any securities obtained through such
investments.
(2) Any investments made under this section shall be for such periods as
may be determined by the Financial Secretary and shall be by way of fixed deposit
with a bank in New Zealand, or by deposit in a Post Office Savings Bank, or in
such securities as are authorised in New Zealand for the investment of public
money.
(3) All such investments shall be charged against a separate account to be
called the Niue Assembly Cash Investment Account, and the interest earned on it
shall be credited to the Niue Government Account and credited to such funds or
accounts within the Niue Government Account as the Financial Secretary
determines.
(4) All money received upon the sale or conversion of any security or upon
the expiration of the period or periods for which money is placed on fixed deposit
at a bank shall be credited to the Niue Assembly Cash Investment Account and
shall become part of the general funds of the Niue Government Account unless
invested for a specific purpose when the money shall be applied for that purpose.

11 Money collected for private persons

(1) Whenever, by virtue of any agreement made by the Government and
any person or body, money due to that person or body is collected by the Financial
Secretary, or by some officer acting on his behalf, that money shall be deemed to
be and shall be dealt with as public money within the meaning of this Act; and
that money or so much of it as becomes payable shall without further appropriation
than this section, be issued and paid to that person in such proportions, in such
manner, and at such times as may be set forth in such agreement.

Public Revenues Act 1959

1517
(2) The Government shall not be liable to any such person for any money so payable into the Niue Government Account or into any separate Fund or account, except for money actually collected under any such agreement.

12 Deposits and trust money

(1) The following shall be deemed to be public money within the meaning
of this Act –
(a) Money deposited with any accounting officer pending the
completion of a transaction whereby the money may become
payable to the Government or repayable to the depositor or any
other person;
(b) Money paid into Court by virtue of any Act, rule or authority
whatsoever;
(c) Money payable to the Government in trust for any purpose.
(2) All such money shall be either paid into the Niue Government Account
or otherwise dealt with and accounted for by the person having custody of it as
the Financial Secretary, subject to this Act and to any rules made under it, directs.
(3) (a) The Financial Secretary may, without further authority than this
section, invest any particular sum or sums of such public money
by way of deposit with the Post Office Savings Bank or with any
bank in Niue.
(b) The investment of any such sum or sums and the period of
investment shall be at the absolute discretion of the Financial
Secretary and no person shall have any right of action against him
or against the Government in respect of the investment or the non-
investment of any such money.
(c) When any such sum or sums become repayable to the depositor or
other person entitled to it there shall be added the amount of the
interest certified by the Financial Secretary to have been earned .
(d) The Financial Secretary may reduce the amount of interest so
payable by the reasonable cost of arranging or administering the
investment.

13 Unclaimed deposits and trust money

Every sum of public money to which section 12 relates which is unclaimed
for a period of one year after having become payable to the depositor or other
person entitled to it shall, with accrued interest (if any) on it, be transferred to and
form part of the Niue Government Account; but the Financial Secretary may issue
and pay the same at any time to any claimant who establishes his claim to it to the
satisfaction of the Financial Secretary.
PART 3
APPROPRIATION OF PUBLIC MONEY

14-18 [Repealed by 2004/270]

19 Overexpenditure of items

(1) Where the head of any department of the Government is of the opinion
that the amount provided in the estimates for any item will be insufficient to meet
expenditure chargeable to that item, he shall report the particulars to the Financial
Secretary who, having regard to the circumstances of the case, may authorise the
over-expenditure of the amount provided for that item.
1518 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) No approval given under this section shall in itself authorise a department to overspend the amount appropriated to any vote.

20 [Repealed by 2004/270]

21 Payments for which no specific appropriation

When any vote specified in an Appropriation Act contains an item for
contingencies, that item shall be deemed to be an appropriation for expenditure
on purposes other than those of the other items of the vote.
PART 4
THE PAYMENT OF PUBLIC MONEY

22 Authority for payment

The annual Appropriation Act shall be the authority for the payment of
money from the Niue Government Account.

23 Imprests

(1) Public money may be issued by way of imprest from the Niue
Government Accounts to such officers or to such accounts as the Financial Secretary
authorises for the payment of amounts payable by the Government.
(2) The Financial Secretary may in such cases as he thinks fit authorise an
imprest or official account to be opened and operated in the name of an officer,
either personally or by his official designation or in the name of an officer.
(3) With the prior approval in writing of the Financial Secretary more than
one officer may be authorised to operate on any such account.

24 [Repealed by 2004/270]

24A Rounding off transactions

(1) (a) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act or any other Act,
the Financial Secretary may, when levying any fee, levy, duty or
impost, or making any assessment, or payment, round off the total
amount charged, levied, assessed or paid (as the case may be) to
the nearest multiple of 5 cents.
(b) Any amount rounded off under this section shall be rounded off in
favour of the person so charged, levied, assessed, or paid.
(2) Where under subsection (1) any amount is paid to any person in excess
of the amount which, but for this section, that person shall have been entitled to,
such excess amount shall be deemed to have been written off as if it were written
off under section 37.
PART 5
ANNUAL ACCOUNTS

25 Financial Secretary to furnish

(1) As soon as possible after the close of the financial year, the Financial
Secretary shall furnish to Cabinet a statement of receipts and payments for that
year together with separate income and expenditure accounts and balance sheets
for such activities, institutions or services of a commercial nature as Cabinet directs.
(2) Subject to the concurrence of the Audit Office, Cabinet may direct that
the commercial accounts and balance sheets prepared in terms of subsection (1)
shall be made up as at such date as he thinks fit.

Public Revenues Act 1959

1519
(3) Such annual accounts are to be transmitted forthwith to the Audit Office and, when finally certified by the Audit Office, are to be presented to the Assembly together with the report of the Audit Office on them.

26 False declarations

PART 6
OFFENCES
Every person who makes any declaration or gives any certificate required to be made or given by this Act, or by any regulations or rules made under it, knowing it to be false, shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment or a term not exceeding 6 months or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units, or to both.

27 Neglect to pay money into account

(1) Every person who refuses or neglects to pay any public money into the
account into which it is payable shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding
2 penalty units.
(2) Every person who refuses or neglects to make any return or furnish
any account, vouchers, or other papers which he is required to make or furnish
under this Act, or under any rules or regulations made under it, shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

28 Failure to appear for examination or produce accounts

Every person who fails to attend at the time and place required of him by
any person under this Act for the purpose of being examined, or who fails to
produce any accounts, books, vouchers, or papers in his possession or under his
control which he is so required to produce, or who refuses to be sworn or to answer
any lawful question shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty
units.

29 General penalty

Every person who is guilty of any wilful act of commission or omission
contrary to any provision of this Act for which no penalty is expressly provided
shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

30 Fines recoverable

All fines incurred under this Act shall, except where it is otherwise expressly
provided, be recovered upon the information of any person appointed by Cabinet
in that behalf either generally or in any particular case.
PART 7
GENERAL PROVISIONS

31-31A [Repealed by 2004/270]

32 Suppression in case of death or bankruptcy

On the death, resignation or removal of any accounting officer the balances
remaining at the credit of his public or official account shall on the appointment
of his successor vest in and be transferred to the public or official account of the
successor, or otherwise dealt with as the Financial Secretary directs; and on the
death, bankruptcy, or insolvency of any such accounting officer those balances
shall not constitute assets of his estate or be in any manner subject to the control of
his legal representative, assignee, or trustee.
1520 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
any public money or stores come shall be deemed to owe to the Government all such money or the value of all such stores for which he has not accounted in such manner as the Financial Secretary may direct; and all such money or the value of all such stores shall be recoverable as money due to the Crown.

35 Financial Secretary’s instructions

All accounting officers and other persons concerned in the collection, receipt,
custody or expenditure of public money or stores shall, subject to the provisions
of this Act and to any rules or regulations made under it, observe instructions
issued by the Financial Secretary with respect to public money or public stores or
to accounting for the same.

36 Regulations and rules

Cabinet may make all such rules or regulations as it deems necessary or
expedient for the purpose of giving full effect to this Act and for the due
administration of it, and in particular for all or any of the following purposes –
(a) For regulating the collection, receipt, custody, banking, issue,
expenditure, care and management of public money, and generally
for the guidance of all persons concerned with it;
(b) For regulating the purchase, safe custody, issue, sale or other
disposal, or writing off of public stores and for rendering accounts
of public stores.

37 Irrecoverable losses

(1) Except as provided by this section the authority of the Assembly shall
be obtained before any losses of public money or stores are finally written off:
Provided that this section shall not apply to any money the payment of which has
been remitted under any statutory authority or by any Court or other tribunal or
to any normal and unavoidable losses of stores.
(2) If any dispute arises as to what constitutes a normal and unavoidable
loss in respect of any stores or class of stores for the purpose of this section, the
decision of Cabinet shall be binding on all parties.

38 Public stores

This Act, and of any regulations or instructions made under it in their
application to public money with any necessary modifications apply to public
stores.

39 Custodians

PART 8
PUBLIC SECURITIES
The Financial Secretary and one other person to be appointed by Cabinet shall be the custodians of public securities.

Public Revenues Act 1959

1521

40 Annual statement of investments

(1) There shall be included in the annual accounts for each financial year a
statement of public securities showing details of public securities held at the
commencement of that financial year, acquired or disposed of during that year
and held at the close of it.
(2) Such statement shall be presented to the Niue Assembly together with
the annual accounts when audited.

41 Taking and release of securities to the Crown

(1) Wherever security is taken in respect of an advance of public money,
unless any enactment provides otherwise, the security shall be given to or taken
in the name of Her Majesty.
(2) Where any security is vested in Her Majesty Cabinet may, on behalf of
Her Majesty, exercise any powers, functions, and rights (including any power of
disposal) and undertake and perform any liabilities, in respect of or in connection
with the security which could be exercised, undertaken or performed by Her
Majesty.

42 Expenditure for protection of public securities

(1) (a) Subject to this section, money may be expended out of any fund or
account of the Niue Government Account for the protection,
preservation and improvement of any real or personal property on
the security of which any money in that fund or account has been
lawfully invested.
(b) The authority conferred by this section may be exercised
notwithstanding the prior exercise in respect of the mortgaged
property of any power of sale or of entry into possession.
(2) The authority conferred by this section shall extend to authorise the
expenditure out of any fund or account as aforesaid of money required for the
planting of any land, the employment of labour on it, the making of further
advances to mortgagors, the carrying on of any farming business, and for such
other purposes as may be considered necessary to prevent or minimise any loss
on the realisation of any securities as aforesaid.
(3) All money expended under this section shall be paid out of money
appropriated for the purpose by the Assembly.
(4) No amount shall be expended under this section in respect of any
property without the specific approval of Cabinet.
(5) This section is in addition to and not in substitution for any powers or
authorities conferred otherwise than by or under this section.
PART 9
SURCHARGES

43 Meaning of “deficiency or loss”

In this Part, “deficiency or loss” means –
(a) Any deficiency or loss of, or failure to fully and properly account
for, public money or public stores, by reason of –
(i) The wilful or negligent omission of any person or persons to
collect, receive, or account for any public money or public stores;
or
(ii) The application and charging of any public money to any
service or purpose for which it was not legally available or
applicable; or
1522 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(iii) The payment of any public money without proper authority or without being properly vouchered; or
(iv) The failure to comply with any enactment or any rules or instructions made or issued pursuant to any enactment;
(b) Any deficiency or loss of public money or public stores, or expenditure of public money, or damage to public stores, or expenditure for the replacement or repair of public stores caused through –
(i) The fraud, default or neglect, or improper or unauthorised use
by any person or persons;
(ii) The failure of any person or persons to comply with any
enactment, or any rules or instructions made or issued under
any enactment.

44 Deficiency or loss of public money or public stores

Where there has been a deficiency or loss of public money or public stores,
the permanent head or administrative head, as the case may be, of the Government
department or Government agency responsible for the money or stores shall, as
soon as practicable after the deficiency or loss occurs, report the matter to the
Financial Secretary.

45 Surcharge

(1) If it appears to the Financial Secretary that there has been any deficiency
or loss in respect of any public money or public stores, the Financial Secretary
may, by notice in writing require any person who appears to the Financial Secretary
to be in default or responsible for such deficiency or loss, to show cause why he
should not be surcharged with the amount of deficiency or loss.
(2) Every notice given under subsection (1) shall –
(i) Specify the amount of the surcharge; and
(ii) Include a statement of the grounds on which it is considered
the person is liable to be surcharged; and
(iii) State the date (being a date not less than 14 days from the date
of the notice) by which the person is required to show cause
why he should not be surcharged.
(3) Where any amount of any deficiency or loss cannot be accurately
determined, the Financial Secretary may estimate the deficiency or loss and, in
the absence of proof to the contrary, that estimate shall for all purposes be deemed
to be correct.
(4) On receipt of an explanation by a person who has been required to
show cause why he should not be surcharged, or, where the Financial Secretary is
satisfied on reasonable grounds that the notice given under subsection (1) has
been received by the person, then in default of any such explanation, the Financial
Secretary shall, if he considers that the circumstances warrant it –
(a) Surcharge the person for the amount of the deficiency or loss or
such lesser amount as he thinks fit; and
(b) Notify the person surcharged in writing of the date by which the
surcharge must be satisfied.
(5) Where the Financial Secretary is of the opinion that 2 or more persons
are responsible for any deficiency or loss, he may surcharge each person for the
full amount of the deficiency or loss, and in that event, those persons shall be
jointly and severally liable for such amount.

Public Revenues Act 1959

1523
(6) The Financial Secretary may revoke, or reduce the amount of any surcharge made under this section.
(7) The amount of any unsatisfied surcharge under this section shall be a debt due to the Crown by the person surcharged, and may be recovered accordingly in the Court, or by way of set-off as provided for in section 47.
(8) If the Financial Secretary so directs, no money (other than salary or
wages) payable to or claimed by a person surcharged under this section shall be
paid to him by the Crown until the surcharge has been satisfied.
(9) Nothing in this section shall prevent the recovery without surcharge
from any person liable to be surcharged, of the amount of any deficiency or loss,
or of such part of it as the Financial Secretary thinks fit, as a debt due to the Crown.
(10) All money recovered under this section shall be paid into the account
which suffered the deficiency or loss in respect of which the surcharge was made.

46 Appeal to High Court

Any person who has been surcharged under section 45(4)(b), and who is
dissatisfied with the surcharge, may within 21 days after the date of service on
him of notice of the surcharge, appeal to the High Court which, after making such
investigation as it deems equitable, may make such order as the Court thinks fit
either confirming the surcharge, or directing the relief of the appellant from it
either wholly or in part in such manner as the Court may direct.

47 Set-off

(1) Where –
(a) Under section 45 the Financial Secretary has surcharged any person;
or
(b) Any person owes any sum of money to the Government or any
agency of the Government and such sum is overdue for payment,
and such person is entitled to be paid any money by the Crown or any agency of
the Government, the Financial Secretary may without further authority than this
section, where any surcharge remains unsatisfied or such sum remains overdue
for payment, set-off any sum to which the person is so entitled against the amount
surcharged or overdue as the case may be, either in one sum or by deduction over
a period of time, and shall send to the person a statement of the amount or amounts
so set-off.
(2) For the purposes of this section, a sum of money shall, in the absence of
evidence to the contrary, be deemed to be overdue for payment when it has been
due and owing for a period of 3 months.
(3) Notwithstanding section 45 (8) a set-off under this section may be made
against salary or wages, provided the amount so set-off does not exceed 20 per
cent in any one pay period of the net amount after income tax of such salary or
wages.

1524 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1525

PUBLIC SERVICE SAVINGS AND LOAN SOCIETY ACT 1980

1980/55 – 23 June 1980

1

Short title

PART 3

2

Interpretation

FINANCIAL PROVISIONS

14

Accounts and audit

PART 1

15

Remuneration Fund

SOCIETY ESTABLISHED

16

Deposits

3

Public Service Savings and Loan Society

17

Withdrawals

established

18

Deposits banked

4

Functions of Society

19

Proportionate sum retained

5

Powers of Society

20

Investment in Government securities

6

Constitution and Rules

21

Loans

7

Registration with Registrar

8

Meetings of Society

PART 4

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

PART 2

22

Sealing of deeds

MANAGEMENT OF SOCIETY

23

Investigation of Society

9

Management of Society

24

Suspension or dissolution

10

Functions of Management Committee

25

[Repealed]

11

Management Committee meetings

12

Procedure

SCHEDULES

13

Officers of Society

To make provision for the establishment of the Public Service Savings and

Loan Society

1 Short title

This is the Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Constitution” means the Constitution of the Public Service Savings and
Loan Society contained in Schedule 1;
“Management Committee” means the Management Committee established
under section 9;
“Officer” includes the Chairman or his Deputy or Secretary or Treasurer of
the Society;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of Incorporated Societies;
“Rules” means the rules of the Management Committee of the Public Service
Savings and Loan Society contained in Schedule 2;
“Society” means the Public Service Savings and Loan Society established
under section 3.
1526 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 1
SOCIETY ESTABLISHED

3 Public Service Savings and Loan Society established

(1) The Niue Public Service Savings and Loan Society is hereby established
and it shall be a body corporate.
(2) The Society shall have perpetual succession and a common seal and
shall be capable of suing and being sued and of doing all such things as bodies
corporate may lawfully do.

4 Functions of Society

The principal functions of the Society shall be –
(a) To encourage thrift among the Society members;
(b) To educate members in financial responsibility;
(c) To receive the savings of members as contribution for shares or on
deposit;
(d) To make loans to members for the purposes specified in the
Constitution; and
(e) To distribute profits under co-operative principles.

5 Powers of Society

The Society shall have full powers –
(a) To establish, operate, manage or maintain such projects, schemes,
or arrangements for the benefits of its members as it may think fit;
(b) To acquire, by purchase or otherwise both real and personal
property of whatsoever kind or nature or wheresoever situate;
(c) To invest moneys on deposit in any bank, or in any bonds, or on
mortgage of any land or buildings, in or outside Niue, or in or on
debentures, debenture-stocks, stocks, funds, shares or securities of
any corporation or company carrying on business in or outside
Niue;
(d) To grant, sell, convey, surrender, yield up, mortgage, demise, let,
reassign, transfer or otherwise dispose of any land, or buildings,
mortgages, debentures, debenture-stocks, funds, securities, vessels,
goods and chattels for the time being vested in the Society, upon
such terms as the Society may deem fit;
(e) To erect any buildings or like construction and effect any
improvement to them;
(f) To borrow or lend money upon such terms as the Society shall think
fit, and to raise money by private subscriptions; and
(g) Generally to do such other things as may appear to be incidental or
conducive to the functions of the Society.

6 Constitution and Rules

(1) (a) The Constitution of the Society may be amended or changed at any
time by Cabinet acting upon a resolution passed by two thirds of
the members present and voting at a general meeting of the Society.
(b) The members present shall not be less than 60.
(2) The Rules may be amended or changed at any time by a resolution
passed at a general meeting of the Society and such amendments or changes shall
be filed with the Registrar under section 7(1)(b).

Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980

1527

7 Registration with Registrar

(1) The Society shall forward to the Registrar for registration the following –
(a) Notice of the address of the registered office of the Society and any
change to it;
(b) A copy of any amendment to the Rules and certified as correct by
at least 2 officers of the Society;
(c) A list of the names and addresses of the members of the Society,
and any change in it, certified as correct by an officer or officers of
the Society;
(d) The name and address of any person or persons appointed under
section 9 to sign deeds, documents and other instruments;
(e) A report concerning its projects, schemes and arrangements during
the year after the end of each financial year;
(f) A statement of its accounts after the end of each financial year; and
(g) A copy of the report of the auditors.
(2) Notification under subsection (1) shall be as soon as conveniently
possible or within such period as the Registrar may reasonably require.
(3) Any person or member may inspect any of the documents registered
under this section.
(4) A fee of $2 shall be payable for registering any document under this
section.
(5) A fee of 50 cents shall be payable for the inspection of documents filed
with the Registrar under this Act.

8 Meetings of Society

(1) There shall be held each year not later than 3 months after the financial
year a general meeting of the Society to be known as the Annual General Meeting.
The order of business shall include –
(a) Minutes of the last Annual General Meeting and any general
meeting held since that meeting;
(b) Report of the Management Committee;
(c) Determination of the rate of interest on share capital;
(d) Consideration of notices of motion;
(e) Election of Management Committee; and
(f) Determinations of the rate of remuneration for the officers of the
Management Committee and the auditor.
(2) In considering subsection (1)(c) the Annual General Meeting shall have
before it a recommendation from the Management Committee. Before the rate of
interest can be approved in variance to that recommended by the Management
Committee a Special Meeting held shall also approve the interest rate so varied.
(3) The Society shall at the request of the Management Committee or at
the written request of at least 10 members call a Special Meeting of the Society.
Any request so made shall state the object of the proposed meeting.
(4) At least 14 days notice of any Annual or Special Meeting shall be given
by individual notice in writing to members and public notice.
(5) Thirty members of the Society shall constitute a quorum.
1528 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 2
MANAGEMENT OF SOCIETY

9 Management of Society

(1) The Annual General Meeting of the Society shall elect from amongst
their members –
(a) A Management Committee of a –
(i) Chairman;
(ii) Vice Chairman;
(iii) Secretary;
(iv) Treasurer;
(v) 1 to 3 other members;
(b) The names of persons elected under paragraph (a) shall be
communicated to Cabinet not later than 14 days after their election.
(2) All members of the Management Committee shall be of the age of 20
years or more.
(3) The Management Committee shall make arrangements for the internal
audit of the accounts of the Society at least once every 3 months or at such intervals
decided upon by the Management Committee.
(4) At the end of each financial year the books and accounts shall be audited
by such person or persons as are appointed by the Management Committee with
the approval of Cabinet.

10 Functions of Management Committee

(1) The general management and control of the Society shall be in the
Management Committee.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1) the Management
Committee shall –
(a) Approve, defer, or reject applications for membership;
(b) Expel or discipline members as provided for in the Constitution;
(c) Approve, defer or reject applications for loans;
(d) Have general responsibility for the investment of funds of the
Society;
(e) Recommend the interest rate on shares to the Annual General
Meeting of the Society; and
(f) Do all such other things as are necessary for the achievement of the
purposes of this Act.

11 Management Committee meetings

(1) The Management Committee shall hold meetings at least once in each
month.
(2) Every meeting shall be presided over by the Chairman or, in the absence
of the Chairman, the Vice Chairman or, in the absence of the Vice Chairman, some
other member of the Management Committee nominated by the Management
Committee to preside over the meeting.
(3) At all meetings of the Management Committee 3 members of the
Management Committee shall form a quorum.
(4) At any meeting of the Management Committee the Chairman or in the
absence of the Chairman, the Vice Chairman or the person nominated to preside
over the meeting shall have a deliberative vote and in the case of an equality of
votes a casting vote.
(5) All questions before the Management Committee shall be decided by a
majority of votes recorded in it.

Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980 1529

12 Procedure

Subject to this Act, and rules made under it, the Management Committee
may regulate its procedure in such manner as it thinks fit.

13 Employees of Society

(1) The Management Committee may employ such persons and take such
other steps as they think necessary and expedient for properly carrying out their
duties.
(2) Any person so appointed may hold office in addition to or in conjunction with any other office.

14 Accounts and audit

PART 3
FINANCIAL PROVISIONS
(1) The Society shall keep or shall cause to be kept proper accounts and other records in respect of its operations and shall cause to be prepared statements of accounts in respect of each financial year as soon as possible.
(2) The accounts of the Society shall be audited by such person or persons
as are appointed under section 9(4).

15 Remuneration Fund

(1) There shall be established a Remuneration Fund to which every member
of the Society shall contribute annually a sum prescribed by the Rules of the Society.
(2) There shall be paid from the Remuneration Fund to the members of
the Management Committee such remuneration by way of salary, fees, or
allowances as may be prescribed by the Rules of the Society either generally or in
respect of any particular person or persons or class or classes of persons.

16 Deposits

Deposits may be received on behalf of the Society upon or subject to such
terms and conditions as may be prescribed by this Act or by any regulations or
Rules made under this Act.

17 Withdrawals

Withdrawals may be made upon or subject to such terms and conditions as
may be prescribed by this Act or Rules made under this Act.

18 Deposits banked

(1) The amount of the deposits and all other sums of money received by
the Society, except so much as is retained for daily requirements, shall with all
convenient speed, be deposited in a trading bank or the Post Office Savings Bank
Account in the name of the Society.
(2) The said account shall be operated only by cheque signed by one
member of the Society for the time being authorised by the Management
Committee in that behalf, and countersigned by one of the Management
Committee.

19 Proportionate sum retained

The Society shall at all times keep in cash or in other resources immediately
available as may be approved in that behalf by Cabinet sums amounting in the
aggregate to not less than 5 percent of the total amount for the time being standing
to the credit of the depositors.
1530 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

20 Investment in Government securities

The Society shall invest a minimum of 20 per cent of its funds in any given
year in Niue Government securities or New Zealand Government securities.

21 Loans

(1) The Society may with the approval of the majority of members at the
Annual General Meeting lend to the Government such sums of money as may be
requested by the Government and the interest on such a loan shall be such figure
as negotiated by the Management Committee and the Cabinet.
(2) The Management Committee shall negotiate an agreement with the
Government over the repayment of the loan.
(3) The Management Committee shall not borrow any money without a
prior resolution of the Society and the prior approval of Cabinet.

22 Sealing of deeds

PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
All deeds, documents and other instruments requiring the seal of the Society shall be signed by an officer of the Society or by such other person or persons as the Society shall appoint and such signing shall be taken as sufficient evidence of the due sealing of such deeds, documents and other instruments.

23 Investigation of Society

The Society may at any time be investigated by Cabinet –
(a) Upon receipt of a resolution of the Society passed by two thirds of
the members present and voting and such resolution to be
forwarded by the Secretary of the Society to the Cabinet not later
than 7 days from the date it was passed, or;
(b) If it has reason to believe that the affairs of the Society are such as to
require an investigation.

24 Suspension or dissolution

The Society may at any time be suspended or dissolved by Cabinet upon
such terms and conditions it may decide –
(a) Upon receipt of a resolution of the Society passed by two thirds of
the members present and voting and such resolution to be
forwarded by the Secretary to the Cabinet not later than 7 days
from the date it was passed;
Provided that not less than 60 members were present; or
(b) If it is satisfied after an investigation has been conducted that the
Society be dissolved.

25 [Repealed by 2004/270]

––––––––––––––––––––

Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980 1531

1 Name

SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE 1

CONSTITUTION OF THE PUBLIC SERVICE SAVINGS AND LOAN SOCIETY

Section 6(1)

The name of the Society shall be the Public Service Savings and Loan Society.

2 Membership

Membership of the Society shall be limited to members and retired members of

the Niue Public Service Association (Incorporated), who in the opinion of the Society are

honest, industrious and of good habits, and for the time being are resident on Niue.

3 Cessation of membership

(1) A member ceases to be a member of the Society –

(a) Upon dissolution of the Society; or

(b) Upon the death of the member; or

(c) Where a member leaves Niue permanently; or

(d) Upon the resignation of a member from the Society.

(2) Upon ceasing to be a member for any reasons whatsoever a member ’s shares

will be refunded less any liability to the Society, and the Management Committee shall

have the power to defer the refund of shares for up to 3 months.

4 Suspension or expulsion

Any member charged with misconduct or attempting to injure the Society in any

manner whatsoever shall, if found guilty by the Management Committee in respect of

such damage, be liable to suspension or expulsion.

5 Disposal of shares

Shares may be transferred from one member to another and subject to the approval

of the Management Committee.

6 Loans

(1) Any member may borrow from the Society.

(2) A loan may be granted to any member of the Society subject to the prior

approval of the Management Committee.

(3) To obtain a loan from the Society a member must apply on the prescribed

form to the Secretary of the Management Committee.

(4) The borrower shall sign an agreement with the Chairman of the Management

Committee or in the absence of the Chairman any other member of the Management

Committee who is authorised for that purpose setting out the terms and conditions of the

loan.

(5) The borrower shall be required to give such security for the repayment of a loan as may be decided by the Committee.

(6) Loans may be granted to members for productive and other purposes but no loan shall be advanced for any purposes which the Management Committee considers to be unnecessary or contrary to the best interests of the member.

(7) A loan shall be applied for a specific purpose and it shall be granted and used

only for that purpose. If a loan or any part of the amount lent is used for any other purpose

the loan shall be immediately recalled in its entirety, by the Management Committee.

1532 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

7 Failure to repay loans

The Management Committee may take such action as may be necessary to recover

arrears of repayments and in the case of persistent defaulting in payment, action may be

taken in the civil court to recover arrears as a debt to the Society.

8 Insurance Fund

There shall be established an Insurance Fund of the Society to which the borrower

shall pay in cash an insurance premium not exceeding one percent of the amount of the

contribution and loan and in the event of the death of the borrower the balance of the

loan shall be a charge against the Insurance Fund but the amount so charged shall not

include the amount of arrears of interest or principal due at the date of death of the

borrower.

9 Banking

(1) All monies paid to the Society shall be paid to the Treasurer of the Society and

shall be deposited by him in the name of the Society in a bank approved by the Society.

(2) All withdrawals from the funds of the Society in a bank must be signed by

any two of the following, namely, the Chairman, Treasurer and Secretary of the

Management Committee.

10 Financial year

The financial year of the Society shall end on 31 December of each year.

11 Income of the Society

Income by way of Post Office Savings Bank interest, interest on loans and other

investments shall at the end of each financial year and after payment of expenses be dealt

by the Society at the Annual General Meeting, as follows –

(a) A third to be placed in a special reserve fund; and

(b) Two thirds payment to members in proportion of the fully paid up shares

standing in a member ’s name as on 31 December each year.

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 2

Section 6(2)

RULES OF THE MANAGEMENT COMMITTEE

1 Functions

Functions of the Management Committee shall be those functions as provided for

in section 10(2) of the Act.

2 Members

The members of the Management Committee shall consist of people appointed

under section 9 of the Act.

3 Chairman

The Chairman shall –

(a) Be responsible for the smooth running and wellbeing of the Management

Committee;

(b) See that the decisions of the Management Committee are carried out

promptly;

(c) Ensure that clear decisions are made on matters under consideration by

the Management Committee;

Public Service Savings and Loan Society Act 1980

1533

(d) Keep the Secretary and the Treasurer up to the required standard in fulfilment of their respective duties;

(e) Go over the Agenda with the Secretary if necessary with the Treasurer as well before any meeting;

(f) Prepare a concise report of the Management Committee’s work during the year of presentation to the General Meeting after 31 December each year.

4 Vice Chairman

The Vice Chairman shall –

(a) Act for the Chairman in his absence; and

(b) Do all he can to aid the Chairman in the proper conduct of the

Management Committee.

5 Secretary

The Secretary shall –

(a) Keep correct and proper minutes of all meetings of the Management

Committee including the general meeting and see that the minutes are

confirmed at the next following meeting;

(b) Keep a record of all members of the Society;

(c) Attend to all the correspondence of the Management Committee;

(d) Receive and submit all applications for loans to the Management

Committee for consideration;

(e) Notify applicants of the Management Committee’s decision;

(f) Arrange a date for the signing of the agreement by the Chairman and the

applicant where a loan is approved;

(g) Obtain from the applicant whose loan is approved an assignment of salary;

(h) Complete the withdrawal slip with the Chairman for the amount of the

loan approved and personally hand it to the Treasurer;

(i) Carry out the decisions of the Management Committee;

(j) Send out Notices of Meeting to all members in good time; and

(k) Go through the accounts with the Treasurer.

6 Treasurer

The Treasurer shall –

(a) Keep proper records of accounts in an orderly and legible manner;

(b) Receive and receipt all membership entrance fees;

(c) Receive and receipt all member ’s shares contributions;

(d) Receive and receipt all members’ loan repayments;

(e) Receive and receipt all members’ insurance premium payments, i.e. on

all approved loans;

(f) Pay all fees, shares contributions, insurance premiums, and loan

repayments into the Society’s Post Office Savings Account;

(g) Arrange payment of loans to applicants only on receipt of their insurance

premium cash payment and receipt of withdrawal slips from the Secretary;

(h) Prepare and present the statement of accounts and balance sheet to the

Management Committee at the end of each three months;

(i) Prepare and present the annual balance sheet to the Management

Committee within one calendar month of the completion of the financial

year for presentation by the Chairman to the General Meeting with his

report; and be ready to assist the Chairman to answer any questions;

1534 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(j) Have the necessary books, cash book, ledger, receipt book, files for accounts and receipts and the like, available to the Auditor or the Management Committee as required; and

(k) Upon the request of any member, present to that member a full statement of that member ’s financial position with the Society.

7 Conditions of loan

(1) A member may borrow from the Society –

(a) An amount equivalent to his fully paid up share or shares; and

(b) An amount equivalent to 50 percent of that fully paid up share or shares.

(2) If a member intends to buy a new car, van or truck, who has had enough

share or shares to enable a member to pay two thirds of the price of the vehicle, the

Management Committee may grant and advance the remaining one third to such member

to enable him or her to pay cash for the vehicle.

(3) Any individual loan at any one time shall not exceed the amount of $9000.

(4) The maximum period for the repayment of a loan will be 5 years.

(5) Where a member borrows from the Society –

(a) An amount equivalent to his fully paid up share or shares the rate of

interest shall be one percent; and

(b) An amount equivalent to fifty percent of the fully paid up share or shares

the interest rate shall be 6 percent increasing to 7 percent for penalty of

the outstanding payments after the expiration date for the agreement.

8 Accounts

The Society’s accounts shall be kept in an orderly and legible manner by the

Treasurer, who shall present a statement to the Management Committee showing the

financial position of the Society as at the end of each 3 months.

9 Reports

The Chairman shall submit a report annually to the General Meeting of the Society.

The report will cover the management and control of the Society’s business for the past

financial year and it shall be accompanied by an audit statement of accounts on the state

of the insurance fund.

10 Remuneration

(1) The members entitled to receive remuneration under section 15 of the Act

shall receive the following amounts –

(a) Chairman $100;

(b) Vice Chairman $60;

(c) Treasurer $200;

(d) Secretary $150; and

(e) Hon Auditor $100.

(2) Every member shall contribute annually to the Remuneration Fund established

under section 15 a sum of $4.

11 Fees

Every member shall pay an entrance fee of $2 which under no circumstances shall

be refundable.

1535

RACE RELATIONS ACT 1972

1972/77 – 28 June 1972

13

Evidence

14

Procedure after investigation

15

Remedies

16

Damages

17

Licences and registration

18

Access by the public to places, vehicles and

facilities

19

Inciting racial disharmony

20

No prosecution without consent

21

Condition in restraint of marriage

22

Offences

23

Other enactments not affected

24

Charitable instruments

25

Savings

To affirm and promote racial equality in Niue and to implement the International Convention on the Elimination of All Forms of Racial Discrimination

1 Short title

This is the Race Relations Act 1972.

2 Act to bind the Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.

3 Access by the public to places, vehicles and facilities

(1) It shall be unlawful for any person –
(a) To refuse to allow any other person access to or use of any place or
vehicle which members of the public are entitled or allowed to enter
or use; or
(b) To refuse any other person the use of any facilities in that place or
vehicle which are available to members of the public; or
(c) To require any other person to leave or to cease to use that place or
vehicle or those facilities –
by reason of the colour, race, or ethnic or national origins of that person or of any
relative or associate of that person.
(2) In this Act “relative”, in relation to any person, means any person who –
(a) Is related to him by blood, marriage, affinity, or adoption; or
(b) Is wholly or mainly dependent on him; or
(c) Is a member of his household.
(3) In this section, “vehicle” includes a vessel, an aircraft, or a hovercraft.
1536 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

4 Provision of goods and services

(1) It shall be unlawful for any person who supplies goods, facilities or
services to the public or to any section of the public –
(a) To refuse or fail on demand to provide any other person with those
goods, facilities, or services; or
(b) To provide any other person with those goods, facilities, or services
on less favourable terms or conditions than those upon or subject
to which he would otherwise make them available –
by reason of the colour, race, or ethnic or national origins of that person or of any
relative of that person as defined in section 3 or of any associate of that person.
(2) For the purpose of subsection (1), but without limiting the meaning of
the terms goods, facilities, and services in that subsection, “facilities” includes
facilities by way of banking or insurance or for grants, loans, credit or finance.

5 Employment

(1) It shall be unlawful for any employer, or any person acting or purporting
to act on behalf of any employer –
(a) To refuse or omit to employ any person on work of any description
which is available and for which that person is qualified; or
(b) To refuse or omit to offer or afford any person the same terms of
employment, conditions of work, and opportunities for training
and promotion as are made available for persons of the same
qualifications employed in the same circumstances on work of that
description; or
(c) To dismiss any person in circumstances in which other persons
employed by that employer on work of that description are not or
would not be dismissed –
by reason of the colour, race, or ethnic or national origins of that person or of any
relative of that person as defined in section 3 or of any associate of that person.
(2) It shall be unlawful for any person concerned with procuring
employment for other persons or procuring employees for any employer to treat
any person seeking employment differently from other persons in the same
circumstances by reason of the colour, race, or ethnic, or national origins of that
person or of any relative of that person as defined in section 3 or of any associate
of that person.
(3) Nothing in this section shall apply in respect of the employment of any
person for any purpose for which persons of a particular ethnic or national origin
have or are commonly found to have a particular qualification or aptitude.
(4) Nothing in this section shall apply to the employment or an application
for employment of a person on a ship or aircraft if the person employed or seeking
employment was engaged or applied for it outside Niue.
(5) In this section, “employment” includes the employment of an
independent contractor.

6 Land, housing and other accommodation

(1) It shall be unlawful for any person, on his own behalf or on behalf or
purported behalf of any principal –
(a) To refuse or fail to dispose of any estate or interest in land or any
residential or business accommodation to any other person; or
(b) To dispose of such an estate or interest or such accommodation to
any person on less favourable terms and conditions than are or
would be offered to other persons; or

Race Relations Act 1972

1537
(c) To treat any person who is seeking to acquire or has acquired such an estate or interest or such accommodation differently from other persons in the same circumstances; or
(d) To deny any person, directly or indirectly, the right to occupy any land or any residential or business accommodation; or
(e) To terminate any estate or interest in land or the right of any person
to occupy any land or any residential or business accommodation –
by reason of the colour, race, or ethnic or national origins of that person or of any
relative of that person as defined in section 3 or of any associate of that person.
(2) It shall be unlawful for any person, on his own behalf or on behalf or
purported behalf of any principal, to impose or seek to impose on any other person
any term or condition which limits, by reference to colour, race, or ethnic or national
origins, the persons or class of persons who may be the licensees or invitees of the
occupier of any land or any residential or business accommodation.
(3) For the purposes of this section –
“dispose” includes sell, assign, lease, let, sublease, sublet, license, or
mortgage, and agree to dispose;
“residential accommodation” includes accommodation in dwelling-house,
flat, hotel, motel, boarding house, or camping ground.

7 Advertisements

It shall be unlawful for any person to publish or display or to cause or
allow to be published or displayed, any advertisement or notice which indicates,
or could reasonably be understood as indicating, an intention to commit a breach
of any of the provisions of sections 3 to 6.

8 Liability of principals and employers

Anything which is done or omitted in contravention of sections 3 to 7 by a
person as the agent or employee of another person shall be treated for the purposes
of sections 3 to 7 as done or omitted by that other person as well as by him, unless
it is done or omitted without that other person’s express or implied authority,
precedent or subsequent.

9 Measures to ensure equality

Anything done or omitted which would otherwise constitute a breach of
sections 4 to 7 shall not constitute such a breach if –
(a) It is done or omitted in good faith for the purposes of assisting or
advancing particular persons or groups of persons or persons of a
particular colour, race, or ethnic or national origin; and
(b) Those groups or persons need or may reasonably be supposed to
need assistance or advancement in order to achieve an equal place
with other members of the community.

10 Civil proceedings

Any person who considers himself aggrieved by a breach of any of the
provisions of sections 3 to 7 (the aggrieved person) may bring civil proceedings in
the Court against any person alleged to have committed the breach, and in those
proceedings the aggrieved person may seek such of the remedies described in
section 15 as he thinks fit.
1538 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

11 Investigation and conciliation where proceedings commenced

(1) Where proceedings are commenced under section 10 the Court shall
refer the case to a conciliator appointed by the Court and shall adjourn the
proceedings accordingly.
(2) The conciliator appointed under subsection (1) shall investigate the case
referred to him and carry out the functions described in section 14.

12 Proceedings of the conciliator

(1) Every investigation by a conciliator appointed under section 11 shall
be conducted in private.
(2) The conciliator may hear or obtain information from such persons as
he thinks fit.
(3) Subject to this Act, the conciliator may regulate his procedure in such a
manner as he thinks fit.

13 Evidence

(1) The conciliator appointed under section 11 may require any person
who in his opinion is able to give any information relating to the matter which is
being investigated by the conciliator to furnish to him any such information and
to produce any documents or papers or things which in the conciliator ’s opinion
relate to any such matter as aforesaid and which may be in the possession or
under the control of that person.
(2) (a) The conciliator may summon before him and examine on oath any
person who in the conciliator ’s opinion is able to give any such
information as aforesaid and for that purpose may administer an
oath.
(b) Every such investigation by the conciliator shall be deemed to be a
judicial proceedings within the meaning of section 181 of the Niue
Act 1966.
(3) Every such person shall be obliged to answer any questions put to him
by the conciliator but shall have the same privilege in relation to the production of
documents and papers and things as witnesses have in any Court.
(4) Except on the trial of any person for perjury within the meaning of the
Niue Act 1966 in respect of his sworn testimony, no statement made or answer
given by that or any other person in the course of the inquiry by or any proceedings
before the conciliator shall be admissible in evidence against any person in any
Court or at any inquiry or in any other proceedings, and no evidence in respect of
proceedings before the conciliator shall be given against any person.
(5) No person shall commit an offence against section 228A of the Niue
Act 1966 or any enactment, other than this Act, by reason of compliance with any
requirement of the conciliator under this section.
(6) Where any person is required by the conciliator to attend before him
for the purposes of this section, the person shall be entitled to the same fees,
allowances, and expenses as if he were a witness in civil proceedings in the Court
and the amounts payable shall be fixed by the Court and paid out of the Niue
Government Account.
(7) Every person appointed a conciliator under section 11 who, except
insofar as it is necessary for him to do so for the proper discharge of his functions
under this Act discloses to any person any information received by him or any
statement or admission made to him in the course of an investigation under section
11 or an endeavour to bring about a settlement under section 14 commits an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

Race Relations Act 1972

1539

14 Procedure after investigation

(1) After investigating a case referred to him under section 11, the conciliator
shall use his best endeavours to secure a settlement acceptable to the parties and,
if he considers it appropriate in a case where he is of the opinion that a breach of
any of the provisions of sections 3 to 7 has occurred, a satisfactory assurance against
the repetition of the act or omission constituting the breach or the doing of further
acts or omissions of a similar kind by the person considered to have committed
the breach.
(2) As soon as reasonably practicable and in any event not later than 60
days after the matter has been referred to him or within such further time as the
Court may allow the conciliator shall furnish a report to the Court which shall
state whether or not the endeavour to secure a settlement between the parties or,
as the case may be, a settlement and an assurance of the kind referred to in
subsection (1), has been successful.
(3) A copy of every such report shall be made available to each party or to
his solicitor or counsel.
(4) (a) If the conciliator reports that he has secured a settlement, or a
settlement and such an assurance as aforesaid, the proceedings shall
lapse but without prejudice to the right of the aggrieved person to
commence fresh proceedings at any time in respect of the same
cause of action if there has been a breach of any term of the
settlement or of the assurance.
(b) In this event, the Court, if it is satisfied that such a breach has
occurred, shall proceed to hear the case and section 11 (1) shall have
no application.
(c) The Court shall otherwise dismiss the case.

15 Remedies

(1) If in any proceedings under section 10 the Court is satisfied on the
balance of probabilities that the defendant has committed a breach of any of the
provisions of sections 3 to 7, it may grant one or more of the following remedies –
(a) A declaration that the defendant has committed a breach of this
Act;
(b) An injunction restraining the defendant from continuing or
repeating the breach or from engaging in, or causing or permitting
others to engage in conduct of the same kind as that constituting
the breach, or conduct of any similar kind specified in the injunction;
(c) Damages under section 16;
(d) A declaration that any contract entered into or performed in
contravention of any of the provisions of sections 3 to 7 is an illegal
contract;
(e) Such other relief as the Court thinks just.
(2) It shall not be a defence to proceedings under this section that the breach
was unintentional or without negligence on the part of the defendant, but the
Court may take the conduct of the defendant into account in granting a remedy.
1540 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

16 Damages

(1) In any proceedings under section 10 the Court may award damages
against the defendant for a breach of any of the provisions of sections 3 to 7 in
respect of any one or more of the following –
(a) Pecuniary loss suffered and expenses reasonably incurred by the
aggrieved person for the purpose of the transaction or activity out
of which the breach arose;
(b) Loss of any benefit which the aggrieved person might reasonably
have been expected to obtain but for the breach;
(c) Humiliation, loss of dignity, and injury to the feelings of the
aggrieved person.
(2) Damages awarded under subsection (1)(c) shall not exceed 200 dollars.

17 Licences and registration

(1) Where any person is licensed or registered under any enactment to
carry on any occupation or activity or where any premises or vehicle are registered
or licensed for any purpose under any enactment, and where the person or other
authority authorised to renew, revoke, cancel, or review any such licence or
registration is satisfied –
(a) That in the carrying on of its occupation or activity; or
(b) That in the use of the premises or vehicle –
there has been a breach of any of the provisions of sections 3 to 7 the person or
authority, in addition to any other powers which that person or authority has, but
subject to subsection (2), may refuse to renew or may revoke or cancel any such
licence or registration, as the case may require, or may impose any other penalty
authorised by the enactment, whether by way of censure, fine, or otherwise.
(2) Any procedural requirements of the enactment, including any whereby
a complaint is a prerequisite to the exercise by the person or authority of its powers
under the enactment, shall be observed.
(3) In any case in which any of the powers conferred by subsection (1) are
exercised –
(a) The person or authority shall in giving its decision state that the
decision is being made under subsection (1); and
(b) Any person who would have been entitled to appeal against that
decision if it had been made on other grounds shall be entitled to
appeal against the decision made under subsection (1).

18 Access by the public to places, vehicles and facilities

(1) Every person commits an offence who –
(a) Refuses to allow any other person access to or use of any place or
vehicle which members of the public are entitled or allowed to enter
or use; or
(b) Refuses any other person the use of any facilities in that place or
vehicle which are available to members of the public; or
(c) Requires any other person to leave or to cease to use that place or
vehicle or those facilities –
by reason of the colour, race, or ethnic or national origins of that person or of any
relative of that person as defined in section 3 or of any associate of that person.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this section is liable to a
fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(3) In this section, “vehicle” includes a vessel, an aircraft, or a hovercraft.

Race Relations Act 1972

1541

19 Inciting racial disharmony

(1) Every person commits an offence and is liable to imprisonment for a
term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units who with
intent to incite hostility or ill-will against, or bring into contempt or ridicule, any
group of persons in Niue on the ground of the colour, race, or ethnic or national
origins of that group of persons –
(a) Publishes or distributes written matter which is threatening,
abusive, or insulting, or broadcasts by means of radio or television
words which are threatening, abusive, or insulting; or
(b) Uses in any public place or within the hearing of persons in any
such public place, or at any meeting to which the public are invited
or have access, words which are threatening, abusive, or insulting,
being matter or words likely to excite hostility, or ill-will against, or bring into
contempt or ridicule, any such group of persons in Niue on the ground of the
colour, race, or ethnic or national origins of that group of persons.
(2) For the purposes of this section –
“publishes” or “distributes” mean publishes or distributes to the public at
large or to any member or members of the public;
“written matter” includes any writing, sign, visible representation, or sound
recording.

20 No prosecution without consent

No prosecution for an offence under section 18 or 19 shall be instituted
without the consent of Cabinet.

21 Condition in restraint of marriage

(1) A condition, whether oral or contained in a deed, will, or other
instrument, which restrains or has the effect of restraining marriage shall be void
if the person or class of person whom the person subject to the condition may or
may not marry is identified or defined, expressly or by implication, by reference
to the colour, race, or ethnic or national origins of the person or class of person.
(2) Nothing in this section shall affect the construction of any deed, will,
or other instrument executed before the commencement of this Act.
(3) For the purposes of this section, the will of any testator who dies after
31 December 1973 shall (notwithstanding the actual date of the execution of it), be
deemed to have been executed after the commencement of this Act.

22 Offences

Every person commits an offence against the Act and is liable to a fine not
exceeding 1 penalty unit who –
(a) Without lawful justification or excuse, wilfully obstructs, hinders,
or resists any person appointed as conciliator under section 11 in
the exercise of his powers under this Act;
(b) Without lawful justification or excuse, refuses or wilfully fails to
comply with any lawful requirement of any person appointed as
conciliator under section 11;
(c) Wilfully makes any false statement to or misleads or attempts to
mislead any person appointed as conciliator under section 11 in
the exercise of his powers under this Act.
1542 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

23 Other enactments not affected

Except as expressly provided in this Act nothing in this Act shall limit or
affect any other enactment.

24 Charitable instruments

(1) Nothing in this Act shall apply to any provision contained in an existing
or future charitable instrument which confers benefits, or enables benefits to be
conferred, on persons of a particular colour, race, or ethnic or national origin, or to
any act done in order to comply with any such provision.
(2) In this section “instrument” means an instrument the purposes of which
are exclusively charitable.

25 Savings

(1) Nothing in this Act shall affect the right to bring any proceedings, either
civil or criminal, which might have been brought if this Act had not been passed,
but, in assessing any damages to be awarded to or on behalf of any person under
this Act or otherwise, a court shall take account of any damages already awarded
to or on behalf of that person in respect of the same cause of action.
(2) No proceedings, civil or criminal, shall lie against any person, except
as provided by this Act, in respect of any act or omission, which is unlawful by
virtue only of sections 3 to 7.
(3) Nothing in this Act shall affect any enactment or law, or any
administrative practice, which distinguishes between New Zealand citizens and
other persons, or between British subjects or Commonwealth citizens (including
citizens of the Republic of Ireland) and aliens, or between Niueans and other
persons.
(4) For the purposes of subsection (3) “enactment” includes any provision
of any notice, consent, approval, or direction which is given by any person pursuant
to a power conferred by any enactment.
1543

REPRINT OF STATUTES ACT 1991

1991/154 24 July 1991

1

2

3

Short title

Interpretation

Powers and functions of Cabinet

4

5

6

Carrying Act into operation Copy of statute to be evidence Judicial notice to be taken of reprint

For compiling reprints or a composite edition of the enactments in force in Niue

1 Short title

This is the Reprint of Statutes Act 1991.

2 Interpretation

For the purposes of this Act –
“statute” means any Act and includes any regulations, rules, orders and
notices made under the authority of an Act.

3 Powers and functions of Cabinet

(1) Cabinet shall have the powers and functions set out in subsection (2),
in the reprint of any statute.
(2) Cabinet may –
(a) Prepare and arrange for the publication of a composite reprint
edition of the Constitution and statutes in such form as Cabinet
shall consider desirable;
(b) Prepare a separate reprint of the Constitution or any statute;
(c) Omit formal, enacting or introductory words;
(d) Unless inconsistent with the context, revise and correct obsolete
references to statutes and any office, department, board or any other
body whatsoever;
(e) Omit all repealed or revoked provisions and may renumber
remaining provisions accordingly;
(f) Make such alterations as may be necessary to conform to current
drafting style and practice, and to reconcile any contradictions,
supply any omissions, and amend any imperfections in the form of
the existing statutes;
(g) Consolidate with all necessary consequential changes, statutes on
the same subject.

4 Carrying Act into operation

Statutes reprinted as aforesaid may be printed and compiled or bound in
such manner as the Cabinet may direct.
1544 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

5 Copy of statute printed to be evidence

Every copy of any statute printed under the authority of this Act shall be
evidence of such statute and of its contents, and every copy of it purporting to be
printed as aforesaid shall be deemed to be so printed unless the contrary is proved.

6 Judicial notice to be taken of reprint

Judicial notice of any statute reprinted pursuant to this Act shall be taken
by all courts and persons acting judicially.
1545

ROYAL TITLES ACT 1974

1974/1 (NZ) – 6 February 1974

1

Short title

2

Royal style and titles

3-4

[Spent]

To define Her Majesty’s royal style and titles in relation to New Zealand

1 Short title

This is the Royal Titles Act 1974.

2 Royal style and titles

The royal style and titles of Her Majesty, for use in relation to Niue, shall be
– Elizabeth the Second, by the Grace of God Queen of New Zealand and Her
other Realms and Territories, Head of the Commonwealth and Defender of the
Faith.…

3-4 [Spent]

1546 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1547

SALE OF GOODS ACT 1908

1908/68 (NZ) – 4 August 1908

1 Short title

2 Interpretation

PART 1

25 Sale under voidable title

26 Revesting of property in stolen goods on

conviction of offender

27 Seller or buyer in possession after sale

FORMATION OF THE CONTRACT

Contract of Sale

3 Sale and agreement to sell

4 Capacity to buy and sell

Formalities of the Contract

5 Contact of sale, how made

6 [Repealed]

Subject-Matter of Contract

7 Existing or future goods

8 Goods which have perished

9 Goods perishing before sale but after

agreement to sell

The Price

10 Ascertainment of price

11 Agreement to sell at valuation

Conditions and Warranties

12 Stipulation as to time

13 When condition to be treated as warranty

14 Implied undertaking as to title

15 Sale by description

16 Implied conditions as to quality or fitness

Sale by Sample

17 Sale by sample

PART 2

EFFECTS OF THE CONTRACT

Transfer of Property as Between Seller and Buyer

18 Goods must be ascertained

19 Property passes when intended to pass

20 Rules for ascertaining intention

21 Reservation of right of disposal

22 Risk prima facie passes with property

Transfer of Title

23 Sale by person not the owner

24 Market overt

28 Effect of writs of execution

PART 3

PERFORMANCE OF THE CONTRACT

29 Duties of seller and buyer

30 Payment and delivery are concurrent

conditions

31 Rules as to delivery

32 Delivery of wrong quantity

33 Instalment deliveries

34 Delivery to carrier

35 Risk where goods delivered at distant place

36 Buyer ’s right of examining goods

37 Acceptance

38 Buyer not bound to return rejected goods

39 Liability of buyer for neglecting or refusing

delivery

PART 4

RIGHTS OF UNPAID SELLER AGAINST THE GOODS

40 “Unpaid seller” defined

41 Unpaid seller ’s rights

Unpaid Seller’s Lien

42 Unpaid seller ’s lien

43 Part delivery

44 Termination of lien

Stoppage in Transit

45 Rights of stoppage in transit

46 Duration of transit

47 How stoppage in transit effected

Resale by Buyer or Seller

48 Effect of subsale or pledge by buyer

49 Sale not generally rescinded by lien or

stoppage in transit

1548 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 5 PART 6

ACTIONS FOR BREACH OF THE CONTRACT SUPPLEMENTARY

Remedies of the Seller

50 Action for price

51 Damages for non-acceptance

Remedies of the Buyer

52 Damages for non-delivery

53 Specific performance

54 Remedy for breach of warranty

55 Interest and special damages, or recovery

of money paid

56 Exclusion of implied terms and conditions

57 Reasonable time a question of fact

58 Rights and duties under Act enforceable by

action

59 Auction sales

60 Savings

SCHEDULE

To consolidate certain enactments relating to the sale of goods

1 Short title

This is the Sale of Goods Act 1908.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“action” includes counterclaim and set-off;
“buyer” means a person who buys or agrees to buy goods;
“contract of sale” includes an agreement to sell as well as a sale;
“delivery” means voluntary transfer of possession from one person to
another;
“document of title to goods” includes any bill of lading, dock warrant,
warehouse keeper ’s certificate, and warrant or order for the delivery
of goods, and any other document used in the ordinary course of
business as proof of the possession or control of goods, or authorising
or purporting to authorise, either by endorsement or by delivery, the
possessor of the document to transfer or receive goods thereby
represented;
“fault” means wrongful act or default;
“future goods” means goods to be manufactured or acquired by the seller
after the making of the contract of sale;
“goods” includes all chattels person other than money or things in action.
The term includes emblements, growing crops, and things attached to
or forming part of the land which are agreed to be severed before sale
or under the contract of sale;
“plaintiff” includes defendant counterclaiming;
“property” means the general property in goods, and not merely a special
property;
“quality of goods” includes their state or condition;
“sale” includes a bargain and sale, as well as a sale and delivery;
“seller” means a person who sells or agrees to sell goods;
“specific goods” means goods identified and agreed on at the time a contract
of sale is made;
“warranty” means an agreement with reference to goods which are the
subject of a contract of sale, but collateral to the main purpose of such
contract, the breach of which gives rise to a claim for damages, but not
to a right to reject the goods and treat the contract as repudiated;

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1549
“writ of execution” means any writ of sale, warrant of distress, or other writ or warrant of execution under which chattels of any kind may be seized or taken to satisfy process issued out of any Court.
(2) A thing is deemed to be done “in good faith” within the meaning of this Act when it is in fact done honestly, whether it is done negligently or not.
(3) A person is deemed to be insolvent, within the meaning of this Act,
who either has ceased to pay his debts in the ordinary course of business, or cannot
pay his debts as they become due, whether he has committed an act of bankruptcy
or not.
(4) Goods are in a “deliverable state” within the meaning of this Act when they are in such a state that the buyer would under the contract be bound to take delivery of them.
PART 1
FORMATION OF THE CONTRACT

Contract of Sale

3 Sale and agreement to sell

(1) A contract of sale of goods is a contract whereby the seller transfers or
agrees to transfer the property in goods to the buyer for a money consideration,
called “the price”.
(2) There may be a contract of sale between one part owner and another.
(3) A contract of sale may be absolute or conditional.
(4) Where under a contract of sale the property in the goods is transferred
from the seller to the buyer the contract is called “a sale”; but where the transfer of
the property in the goods is to take place at a future time, or subject to some
condition thereafter to be fulfilled, the contract is called “an agreement to sell”.
(5) An agreement to sell becomes a sale when the time elapses or the
conditions are fulfilled subject to which the property in the goods is to be
transferred.

4 Capacity to buy and sell

(1) (a) Capacity to buy and sell is regulated by the general law concerning
capacity to contract, and to transfer and acquire property.
(b) Where necessaries are sold and delivered to a person who by reason
of mental incapacity or drunkenness is incompetent to contract, he
must pay a reasonable price for them.
(2) “Necessaries” in this section means goods suitable to the condition in
life of the person, and to his actual requirements at the time of the sale and delivery.

Formalities of the Contract

5 Contract of sale, how made

(1) Subject to this and any other Act, a contract of sale may be made in
writing (either with or without seal), or by word of mouth, or partly in writing
and partly by word of mouth, or may be implied from the conduct of the parties.
(2) Nothing in this section shall affect the law relating to corporations.

6 [Repealed]

1550 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Subject-Matter of Contract

7 Existing or future goods

(1) The goods which form the subject of a contract of sale may be either
existing goods, owned or possessed by the seller, or goods to be manufactured or
acquired by the seller after the making of the contract of sale, in this Act called
“future goods”.
(2) There may be a contract for the sale of goods, the acquisition of which
by the seller depends upon a contingency which may or may not happen.
(3) Where by a contract of sale the seller purports to effect a present sale of
future goods, the contract operates as an agreement to sell the goods.

8 Goods which have perished

Where there is a contract for the sale of specific goods, and the goods without
the knowledge of the seller have perished at the time when the contract is made,
the contract is void.

9 Goods perishing before sale but after agreement to sell

Where there is an agreement to sell specific goods, and subsequently the
goods, without any fault on the part of the seller or buyer, perish before the risk
passes to the buyer, the agreement is thereby avoided.

10 Ascertainment of price

The Price

(1) The price in a contract of sale may be fixed by the contract, or may be left to be fixed in manner thereby agreed, or may be determined by the course of dealing between the parties.
(2) Where the price is not determined under subsection (1) the buyer must
pay a reasonable price.
(3) What is a reasonable price is a question of fact, dependent on the
circumstances of each particular case.

11 Agreement to sell at valuation

(1) (a) Where there is an agreement to sell goods on the terms that the
price is to be fixed by the valuation of a third party, and such third
party cannot or does not make such valuation, the agreement is
avoided.
(b) If the goods or any part have been delivered to and appropriated
by the buyer he must pay a reasonable price for them.
(2) Where such third party is prevented from making the valuation by the
fault of the seller or buyer, the party not in fault may maintain an action for damages
against the party in fault.

Conditions and Warranties

12 Stipulations as to time

(1) Unless a different intention appears from the terms of the contract,
stipulations as to time of payment are not deemed to be of the essence of a contract
of sale.
(2) Whether any other stipulation as to time is of the essence of the contract
or not depends on the terms of the contract.
(3) In a contract of sale “month” means prima facie calendar month.

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1551

13 When condition to be treated as warranty

(1) Where a contract of sale is subject to any condition to be fulfilled by the
seller, the buyer may waive the condition, or may elect to treat the breach of such
condition as a breach of warranty, and not as a ground for treating the contract as
repudiated.
(2) Whether a stipulation in a contract of sale is a condition, the breach of
which may give rise to a right to treat the contract as repudiated, or a warranty,
the breach of which may give rise to a claim for damages but not to a right to reject
the goods and treat the contract as repudiated, depends in each case on the
construction of the contract. A stipulation may be a condition, though called a
“warranty” in the contract.
(3) Where a contract of sale is not severable, and the buyer has accepted
the goods or part of it, or where the contract is for specific goods the property in
which has passed to the buyer, the breach of any condition to be fulfilled by the
seller can only be treated as a breach of warranty, and not as a ground for rejecting
the goods and treating the contract as repudiated, unless there is a term of the
contract, express or implied, to that effect.
(4) Nothing in this section shall affect the case of any condition or warranty
fulfilment of which is excused by law by reason of impossibility or otherwise.

14 Implied undertaking as to title

In a contract of sale, unless the circumstances of the contract are such as to
show a different intention, there is –
(a) An implied condition on the part of the seller that in the case of a
sale he has a right to sell the goods, and that in the case of an
agreement to sell he will have a right to sell the goods at the time
when the property is to pass;
(b) An implied warranty that the buyer shall have and enjoy quiet
possession of the goods;
(c) An implied warranty that the goods are free from any charge or
encumbrance in favour of any third party, not declared or known
to the buyer before or at the time when the contract is made.

15 Sale by description

Where there is a contract for the sale of goods by description there is an
implied condition that the goods shall correspond with the description; and if the
sale is by sample, as well as by description, it is not sufficient that the bulk of the
goods corresponds with the sample if the goods do not also correspond with the
description.

16 Implied conditions as to quality or fitness

Subject to this and any other Act, there is no implied warranty or condition
as to the quality or fitness for any particular purpose of goods supplied under a
contract of sale, except as follows –
(a) Where the buyer, expressly or by implication, makes known to the
seller the particular purpose for which the goods are required, so
as to show that the buyer relies on the seller ’s skill or judgement,
and the goods are of a description which it is in the course of the
seller ’s business to supply (whether he is the manufacturer or not),
there is an implied condition that the goods shall be reasonably fit
for such purpose:
1552 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
Provided that in the case of a contract for the sale of a specified article under its patent or other trade name, there is no implied condition as to its fitness for any particular purpose;
(b) Where goods are brought by description from a seller who deals in goods of that description (whether he is the manufacturer or not), there is an implied condition that the goods shall be of merchantable quality:
Provided that if the buyer has examined the goods, there shall be no implied condition as regards defects which such examination ought to have revealed;
(c) An implied warranty or condition as to quality or fitness for a particular purpose may be annexed by the usage of trade;
(d) An express warranty or condition does not negative a warranty or condition implied by this Act unless inconsistent therewith.

17 Sale by sample

Sale by Sample

(1) A contract of sale is a contract for sale by sample where there is a term in the contract, express or implied, to that effect.
(2) In the case of a contract for sale by sample, there is an implied condition– (a) That the bulk shall correspond with the sample in quality;
(b) That the buyer shall have a reasonable opportunity of comparing the bulk with the sample; and
(c) That the goods shall be free from any defect, rendering them
unmerchantable, which would not be apparent on reasonable
examination of the sample.
PART 2
EFFECTS OF THE CONTRACT

Transfer of Property as Between Seller and Buyer

18 Goods must be ascertained

Where there is a contract for the sale of unascertained goods, no property
in the goods is transferred to the buyer unless and until the goods are ascertained.

19 Property passes when intended to pass

(1) Where there is a contract for the sale of specific or ascertained goods,
the property in them is transferred to the buyer at such time as the parties to the
contract intend it to be transferred.
(2) For the purpose of ascertaining the intention of the parties, regard shall
be had to the terms of the contract, the conduct of the parties, and the circumstances
of the case.

20 Rules for ascertaining intention

Unless a different intention appears, the following are rules for ascertaining
the intention of the parties as to the time at which the property in the goods is to
pass to the buyer:
Rule 1. Where there is an unconditional contract for the sale of specific
goods, in a deliverable state, the property in the goods passes to the buyer when
the contract is made, and it is immaterial whether the time of payment or the time
of delivery, or both, is postponed.
Rule 2. Where there is a contract for the sale of specific goods, and the
seller is bound to do something to the goods for the purpose of putting them into

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1553
a deliverable state, the property does not pass until such thing is done, and the buyer has notice of it.
Rule 3. Where there is a contract for the sale of specific goods in a deliverable state, but the seller is bound to weigh, measure, test, or do some other act or thing with reference to the goods for the purpose of ascertaining the price, the property does not pass until such act or thing is done, and the buyer has notice of it.
Rule 4. Where goods are delivered to the buyer on approval, or “on sale or return” or other similar terms, the property in it passes to the buyer –
(a) When he signifies his approval or acceptance to the seller, or does
any other act adopting the transaction;
(b) If he does not signify his approval or acceptance to the seller, but
retains the goods without giving notice of rejection then, if a time
has been fixed for the return of the goods, on the expiration of such
time, and if no time has been fixed, on the expiration of a reasonable
time. What is a reasonable time is a question of fact.
Rule 5. (1) Where there is a contract for the sale of unascertained or future
goods by description, and goods of that description and in a deliverable state are
unconditionally appropriated to the contract, either by the seller with the assent
of the buyer or by the buyer with the assent of the seller, the property in the goods
thereupon passes to the buyer. Such assent may be expressed or implied, and may
be given either before or after the appropriation is made.
(2) Where, in pursuance of the contract, the seller delivers the goods to the
buyer, or to a carrier or other bailee (whether named by the buyer or not) for the
purpose of transmission to the buyer, and does not reserve the right of disposal,
he is deemed to have unconditionally appropriated the goods to the contract.

21 Reservation of right of disposal

(1) Where there is a contract for the sale of specific goods, or where goods
are subsequently appropriated to the contract, the seller may, by the terms of the
contract or appropriation, reserve the right of disposal of the goods until certain
conditions are fulfilled.
(2) In such case, notwithstanding the delivery of the goods to the buyer, or
to a carrier or other bailee for the purpose of transmission to the buyer, the property
in the goods does not pass to the buyer until the conditions imposed by the seller
are fulfilled.
(3) Where goods are shipped, and by the bill of lading the goods are
deliverable to the order of the seller or his agent, the seller is prima facie deemed
to reserve the right of disposal.
(4) Where the seller of goods draws on the buyer for the price, and transmits
the bill of exchange and bill of lading to the buyer together to secure acceptance or
payment of the bill of exchange, the buyer is bound to return the bill of lading if
he does not honour the bill of exchange, and if he wrongfully retains the bill of
lading the property in the goods does not pass to him.

22 Risk prima facie passes with property

(1) (a) Unless otherwise agreed, the goods remain at the seller ’s risk until
the property in them is transferred to the buyer; but when the
property in them is transferred to the buyer the goods are at the
buyer ’s risk, whether delivery has been made or not.
(b) Where delivery has been delayed through fault of either buyer or
seller, the goods are at the risk of the party if fault as regards any
loss which might not have occurred but for such fault.
1554 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) Nothing in this section shall affect the duties or liabilities of either seller or buyer as a bailee of the goods of the other party.

Transfer of Title

23 Sale by person not the owner

(1) Subject to this Act, where goods are sold by a person who is not the
owner of them, and who does not sell them under the authority or with the consent
of the owner, the buyer acquires no better title to the goods than the seller had,
unless the owner of the goods is by his conduct precluded from denying the seller ’s
authority to sell.
(2) Nothing in this Act shall affect –
(a) The Mercantile Law Act 1908, or any other enactment enabling the
apparent owner of goods to dispose of them as if he were the true
owner of them;
(b) The validity of any contract of sale under any special common law
or statutory power of sale, or under the order of a Court of
competent jurisdiction.

24 Market overt

The law relating to market overt shall not apply in Niue.

25 Sale under voidable title

Where the seller of goods has a voidable title to them, but his title has not
been avoided at the time of the sale, the buyer acquires a good title to the goods,
provided he buys them in good faith and without notice of the seller ’s defect of
title.

26 Revesting of property in stolen goods on conviction of offender

(1) Where goods have been stolen and the offender is prosecuted to
conviction, the property in the goods so stolen revests in the person who was the
owner of the goods, or his personal representative, notwithstanding any
intermediate dealing with them, whether by sale in market overt or otherwise.
(2) Notwithstanding any enactment to the contrary, where goods have been
obtained by fraud or other wrongful means not amounting to theft, the property
in such goods shall not revest in the person who was the owner of the goods, or
his personal representative, by reason only of the conviction of the offender.

27 Seller or buyer in possession after sale

(1) Where a person, having sold goods continues or is in possession of the
goods, or of the documents of title to the goods, the delivery or transfer by that
person, or by a mercantile agent acting for him, of the goods or documents of title
under any sale, pledge, or other disposition of it, or under any agreement for sale,
pledge, or other disposition of it, to any person receiving the same in good faith
and without notice of the previous sale, shall have the same effect as if the person
making the delivery or transfer were expressly authorised by the owner of the
goods to make the same.
(2) Where a person, having brought or agreed to buy goods, obtains, with
the consent of the seller, possession of the goods or the documents of title to the
goods, the delivery or transfer by that person, or by a mercantile agent acting for
him, of the goods or documents of title, under any sale, pledge, or other disposition
of it, or under any agreement for sale, pledge, or other disposition of it, to any
person receiving the same in good faith and without notice of any lien or other

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1555
right of the original seller in respect of the goods, shall have the same effect as if the person making the delivery or transfer were a mercantile agent in possession of the goods or documents of title with the consent of the owner:
Provided that if the lien or other right of the original seller is expressed in an instrument duly registered under the Chattels Transfer Act 1924, and if the person selling, pledging, or disposing of the goods or agreeing so to do is the mortgagor or bailee named in such instrument, then the person receiving the goods shall be deemed to have had notice of the contents of such instrument.
(3) In this section “mercantile agent” has the same meaning as in Part 1 of
the Mercantile Law Act 1908.

28 Effect of writs of execution

(1) (a) A writ of execution against goods binds the property in the goods
of the execution debtor as from the time when the writ is delivered
to the Sheriff to be executed; and, for the better manifestation of
such time, the Sheriff shall, without fee, upon the receipt of any
such writ, endorse on the back thereof the hour, day, month and
year when he received the same.
(b) No such writ shall prejudice the title to such goods acquired by any
person in good faith and for valuable consideration, unless such
person had at the time when he acquired his title notice that such
writ or any other writ under which the goods of the execution debtor
might be seized or attached had been delivered to and remained
unexecuted in the hands of the Sheriff.
(2) In this section “Sheriff” includes any officer charged with the
enforcement of a writ of execution.
PART 3
PERFORMANCE OF THE CONTRACT

29 Duties of seller and buyer

It is the duty of the seller to deliver the goods, and of the buyer to accept
and pay for them under the terms of the contract of sale.

30 Payment and delivery are concurrent conditions

Unless otherwise agreed, delivery of the goods and payment of the price
are concurrent conditions – that is to say, the seller must be ready and willing to
give possession of the goods to the buyer in exchange for the price, and the buyer
must be ready and willing to pay the price in exchange for possession of the goods.

31 Rules as to delivery

(1) Whether it is for the buyer to take possession of the goods or for the
seller to send them to the buyer is a question depending in each case on the contract,
express or implied, between the parties.
(2) (a) Apart from any such contract, express or implied, the place of
delivery is the seller ’s place of business, if he has one, and if not,
his residence.
(b) If the contract is for the sale of specific goods, which to the
knowledge of the parties when the contract is made are in some
other place, then that place is the place of delivery.
(3) Where under the contract of sale the seller is bound to send the goods
to the buyer, but no time for sending them is fixed, the seller is bound to send
them within a reasonable time.
1556 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(4) (a) Where the goods at the time of sale are in the possession of a third person, there is no delivery by seller to buyer unless and until such third person acknowledges to the buyer that he holds the goods on his behalf.
(b) Nothing in this section shall affect the operation of the issue or transfer of any document of title to goods.
(5) (a) Demand or tender of delivery may be treated as ineffectual unless made at a reasonable hour;
(b) What is a reasonable hour is a question of fact.
(6) Unless otherwise agreed, the expenses of and incidental to putting the
goods into a delivery state must be borne by the seller.

32 Delivery of wrong quantity

(1) Where the seller delivers to the buyer a quantity of goods less than he
contracted to sell, the buyer may reject them, but if the buyer accepts the goods so
delivered he must pay for them at the contract rate.
(2) Where the seller delivers to the buyer a quantity of goods larger than
he contracted to sell, the buyer may accept the goods included in the contract and
reject the rest, or he may reject the whole. If the buyer accepts the whole of the
goods so delivered he must pay for them at the contract rate.
(3) Where the seller delivers to the buyer the goods he contracted to sell
mixed with goods of a different description not included in the contract, the buyer
may accept the goods which are under the contract and reject the rest, or he may
reject the whole.
(4) The provisions of this section are subject to any usage of trade, special
agreement, or course of dealing between the parties.

33 Instalment deliveries

(1) Unless otherwise agreed, the buyer of goods is not bound to accept
delivery of it by instalments.
(2) Where there is a contract for the sale of goods to be delivered by stated
instalments, which are to be separately paid for, and the seller makes defective
deliveries in respect of one or more instalments, or the buyer neglects or refuses to
take delivery of or pay for one or more instalments, it is a question in each case
depending on the terms of the contract and the circumstances of the case, whether
the breach of contract is a repudiation of the whole contract or whether it is a
severable breach, giving rise to a claim for compensation but not to a right to treat
the whole contract as repudiated.

34 Delivery to carrier

(1) Where, under a contract of sale, the seller is authorised or required to
send the goods to the buyer, delivery of the goods to a carrier, whether named by
the buyer or not, for the purpose of transmission to the buyer is prima facie deemed
to be a delivery of the goods to the buyer.
(2) (a) Unless otherwise authorised by the buyer, the seller must make
such contract with the carrier on behalf of the buyer as may be
reasonable, having regard to the nature of the goods and the other
circumstances of the case.
(b) If the seller omits so to do, and the goods are lost or damaged in
course of transit, the buyer may decline to treat the delivery to the
carrier as a delivery to himself, or may hold the seller responsible
in damages.

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1557
(3) Unless otherwise agreed, where goods are sent by the seller to the buyer by a route involving sea transit, under circumstances in which it is usual to insure, the seller must give such notice to the buyer as may enable him to insure them during their sea transit, and, if the seller fails to do so, the goods shall be deemed to be at his risk during such sea transit.

35 Risk where goods delivered at distant place

Where the seller of goods agrees to deliver them at his own risk at a place
other than that where they are when sold, the buyer must, nevertheless, unless
otherwise agreed, take any risk of deterioration in the goods necessarily incident
to the course of transit.

36 Buyer’s right of examining goods

(1) Where goods are delivered to the buyer, which he has not previously
examined, he is not deemed to have accepted them unless and until he has had a
reasonable opportunity of examining them for the purpose of ascertaining whether
they are in conformity with the contract.
(2) Unless otherwise agreed, when the seller tenders delivery of goods to
the buyer, he is bound, on request, to afford the buyer a reasonable opportunity of
examining the goods for the purpose of ascertaining whether they are in conformity
with the contract.

37 Acceptance

The buyer is deemed to have accepted the goods when he intimates to the
seller that he has accepted them, or when the goods have been delivered to him,
and he does any act in relation to them which is inconsistent with the ownership
of the seller, or when after the lapse of a reasonable time he retains the goods,
without intimating to the seller that he has rejected them.

38 Buyer not bound to return rejected goods

Unless otherwise agreed, where goods are delivered to the buyer, and he
refuses to accept them, having the right so to do, he is not bound to return them to
the seller, but it is sufficient if he intimates to the seller that he refuses to accept
them.

39 Liability of buyer for neglecting or refusing delivery

(1) Where the seller is ready and willing to deliver the goods, and requests
the buyer to take delivery, and the buyer does not within a reasonable time after
such request take delivery of the goods, he is liable to the seller for any loss
occasioned by his neglect or refusal to take delivery, and also for a reasonable
charge for the care and custody of the goods.
(2) Nothing in this section shall affect the rights of the seller where the
neglect or refusal of the buyer to take delivery amounts to a repudiation of the
contract.
PART 4
RIGHTS OF UNPAID SELLER AGAINST THE GOODS

40 “Unpaid seller” defined

(1) The seller of goods is deemed to be an “unpaid seller”, within the
meaning of this Act –
(a) When the whole of the price has not been paid or tendered;
(b) When a bill of exchange or other negotiable instrument has been
received as conditional payment, and the condition on which it was
received has not been fulfilled by reason of the dishonour of the
instrument or otherwise.
1558 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) In this Part, “seller” includes any person who is in the position of a seller, as, for instance, an agent of the seller to whom the bill of lading has been endorsed, or a consignor or agent who has himself paid or is directly responsible for the price.

41 Unpaid seller’s rights

(1) Subject to this Act, and of any statute in that behalf, notwithstanding
that the property in the goods may have passed to the buyer, the unpaid seller of
goods, as such, has, by implication of law –
(a) A lien on the goods, or right to retain them for the price, while he is
in possession of them;
(b) In case of the insolvency of the buyer, a right of stopping the goods
in transit after he has parted with the possession of them;
(c) A right of resale, as limited by this Act.
(2) Where the property in goods has not passed to the buyer, the unpaid
seller has, in addition to his other remedies, right of withholding delivery similar
to and co-extensive with his rights of lien and stoppage in transit where the
property has passed to the buyer.

42 Unpaid seller’s lien

Unpaid Seller’s Lien

(1) Subject to this Act, the unpaid seller of goods who is in possession of them is entitled to retain possession of them until payment or tender of the price in the following cases, namely –
(a) Where the goods have been sold without any stipulation as to credit; (b) Where the goods have been sold on credit, but the term of credit
has expired;
(c) Where the buyer becomes insolvent.
(2) The seller may exercise his right of lien, notwithstanding that he is in
possession of the goods as agent or bailee for the buyer.

43 Part delivery

Where an unpaid seller has made part delivery of the goods, he may exercise
his right of lien or retention on the remainder, unless such part delivery has been
made under such circumstances as to show an agreement to waive the lien or
right of retention.

44 Termination of lien

(1) The unpaid seller of goods loses his lien or right of retention thereon –
(a) When he delivers the goods to a carrier or other bailee for the
purpose of transmission to the buyer without reserving the right of
disposal of the goods;
(b) When the buyer or his agent lawfully obtains possession of the
goods;
(c) By waiver of it.
(2) The unpaid seller of goods, having a lien or right of retention on it,
does not lose his lien or right of retention by reason only that he has obtained
judgment for the price of the goods.

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1559

Stoppage in Transit

45 Right of stoppage in transit

Subject to this Act, when the buyer of goods becomes insolvent, the unpaid
seller who has parted with the possession of the goods has the right of stopping
them in transit – that is to say, he may resume possession of the goods as long as
they are in course of transit, and may retain them until payment or tender of the
price.

46 Duration of transit

(1) Goods are deemed to be in course of transit from the time when they
are delivered to a carrier by land or water, or other bailee for the purpose of
transmission to the buyer, until the buyer, or his agent in that behalf, takes delivery
of them from such carrier or other bailee.
(2) If the buyer or his agent in that behalf obtains delivery of the goods
before their arrival at the appointed destination, the transit is at an end.
(3) If, after the arrival of the goods at the appointed destination, the carrier
or other bailee acknowledges to the buyer or his agent that he holds the goods on
his behalf, and continues in possession of them as bailee for the buyer, or his
agent, the transit is at an end, and it is immaterial that a further destination for the
goods may have been indicated by the buyer.
(4) If the goods are rejected by the buyer, and the carrier or other bailee
continues in possession of them, the transit is not deemed to be at an end, even if
the seller has refused to receive them back.
(5) When goods are delivered to a ship chartered by the buyer, it is a
question, depending on the circumstances of the particular case, whether they are
in the possession of the master as a carrier or as agent to the buyer.
(6) Where the carrier or other bailee wrongfully refuses to deliver the goods
to the buyer, or his agent in that behalf, the transit is deemed to be at an end.
(7) Where part delivery of the goods has been made to the buyer, or his
agent in that behalf, the remainder of the goods may be stopped in transit, unless
such part delivery has been made under such circumstances as to show an
agreement to give up possession of the whole of the goods.

47 How stoppage in transit effected

(1) (a) The unpaid seller may exercise his right of stoppage in transit either
by taking actual possession of the goods, or by giving notice of his
claim to the carrier or other bailee in whose possession the goods
are.
(b) Such notice may be given either to the person in actual possession
of the goods or to his principal. In the latter case the notice, to be
effectual, must be given at such time and under such circumstances
that the principal, by the exercise of reasonable diligence, may
communicate it to his servant or agent in time to prevent a delivery
to the buyer.
(2) (a) When notice of stoppage in transit is given by the seller to the carrier,
or other bailee in possession of the goods, he must redeliver the
goods to or according to the directions of the seller.
(b) The expenses of such redelivery must be borne by the seller.
1560 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Resale by Buyer or Seller

48 Effect of subsale or pledge by buyer

(1) Subject to this Act, the unpaid seller ’s right of lien or retention or
stoppage in transit is not affected by any sale or other disposition of the goods
which the buyer may have made, unless the seller has assented.
(2) Where a document of title to goods has been lawfully transferred to
any person as buyer or owner of the goods, and that person transfers the document
to a person who takes the document in good faith and for valuable consideration,
then, if such last-mentioned transfer was by way of sale, the unpaid seller ’s right
of lien or retention or stoppage in transit is defeated, and if such last-mentioned
transfer was by way of pledge or other disposition for value, the unpaid seller ’s
right of lien or retention or stoppage in transit can only be exercised subject to the
rights of the transferee.

49 Sale not generally rescinded by lien or stoppage in transit

(1) Subject to this section, a contract of sale is not rescinded by the mere
exercise by an unpaid seller of his right of lien or retention or stoppage in transit.
(2) Where an unpaid seller who has exercised his right of lien or retention
or stoppage in transit resells the goods, the buyer acquires a good title thereto as
against the original buyer.
(3) Where the goods are of a perishable nature, or where the unpaid seller
gives notice to the buyer of his intention to resell, and the buyer does not within a
reasonable time pay or tender the price, the unpaid seller may resell the goods
and recover from the original buyer damages for any loss occasioned by his breach
of contract.
(4) Where the seller expressly reserves a right of resale in case the buyer
should make default, and on the buyer making default resells the goods, the
original contract of sale is thereby rescinded, but without prejudice to any claim
the seller may have for damages.
PART 5
ACTIONS FOR BREACH OF THE CONTRACT

Remedies of the Seller

50 Action for price

(1) Where, under a contract of sale, the property in the goods has passed
to the buyer, and the buyer wrongfully neglects or refuses to pay for the goods
under the terms of the contract, the seller may maintain an action against him for
the price of the goods.
(2) Where, under a contract of sale, the price is payable on a day certain
irrespective of delivery, and the buyer wrongfully neglects or refuses to pay such
price, the seller may maintain an action for the price, although the property in the
goods has not passed, and the goods have not been appropriated to the contract.

51 Damages for non-acceptance

(1) Where the buyer wrongfully neglects or refuses to accept and pay for
the goods, the seller may maintain an action against him for damages for non­
acceptance.
(2) The measure of damages is the estimated loss directly and naturally
resulting, in the ordinary course of events, from the buyer ’s breach of contract.
(3) Where there is an available market for the goods in question, the
measure of damages is prima facie to be ascertained by the difference between the
contract prize and the market or current price at the time or times when the goods
ought to have been accepted, or if no time was fixed for acceptance, then t the
time of the refusal to accept.

Sale of Goods Act 1908

1561

Remedies of the Buyer

52 Damages for non-delivery

(1) Where the seller wrongfully neglects or refuses to deliver the goods to
the buyer, the buyer may maintain an action against the seller for damages for
non-delivery.
(2) The measure of damages is the estimated loss directly and naturally
resulting, in the ordinary course of events, from the seller ’s breach of contract.
(3) Where there is an available market for the goods in question the measure
of damages is prima facie to be ascertained by the difference between the contract
prize and the market or current price of the goods at the time or times when they
ought to have been delivered, or if no time was fixed, then at the time of the
refusal to deliver.

53 Specific performance

(1) In an action for breach of contract to deliver specific or ascertained
goods the Court may on the application of the plaintiff, by its judgment direct
that the contract shall be performed specifically, without giving the defendant the
option of retaining the goods on payment of damages.
(2) The judgement may be unconditional, or upon such terms and
conditions as to damages, payment of the price, and otherwise, as the Court deems
just; and the application by the plaintiff may be made at any time before judgment.

54 Remedy for breach of warranty

(1) Where there is a breach of warranty by the seller, or where the buyer
elects or is compelled to treat any breach of a condition on the part of the seller as
a breach of warranty, the buyer is not by reason only of such breach of warranty
entitled to reject the goods; but he may –
(a) Set up against the seller the breach of warranty in diminution or
extinction of the price; or
(b) Maintain an action against the seller for damages for the breach of
warranty.
(2) The measure of damages for breach of warranty is the estimated loss
directly and naturally resulting in the ordinary course of events, from the breach
of warranty.
(3) In the case of breach of warranty of quality, such loss is prima facie the
difference between the value of the goods at the time of delivery to the buyer and
the value they would have had if they had answered to the warranty.
(4) The fact that the buyer has set up the breach of warranty in diminution
or extinction of the price does not prevent him from maintaining an action for the
same breach of warranty if he has suffered further damage.

55 Interest and special damages, or recovery of money paid

Nothing in this Act shall affect the right of the buyer or the seller to recover
interest or special damages in any case where by law interest or special damages
may be recoverable, or to recover money paid when the consideration for the
payment of it has failed.
1562 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 6
SUPPLEMENTARY

56 Exclusion of implied terms and conditions

Where any right, duty or liability would arise under a contract of sale by
implication of law, it may be negatived or varied by express agreement or by the
course of dealing between the parties, or by usage, if the usage is such as to bind
both parties to the contract.

57 Reasonable time a question of fact

Where by this Act any reference is made to a “reasonable time”, the question
what is a reasonable time is a question of fact.

58 Rights and duties under Act enforceable by action

Where any right, duty, or liability is declared by this Act, it may, unless
otherwise by this Act provided, be enforced by action.

59 Auction sales

(1) Where goods are put up for sale by auction in lots, each lot is prima
facie deemed to be the subject of a separate contract of sale.
(2) A sale by auction is complete when the auctioneer announces its
completion by the fall of the hammer, or in other customary manner: until such
announcement is made any bidder may retract his bid.
(3) (a) Where a sale by auction is not notified to be subject to a right to bid
on behalf of the seller, the seller shall not bid himself or employ
any person to bid at such sale, nor shall the auctioneer knowingly
take any bid from the seller or any such person.
(b) Any sale contravening this rule may be treated as fraudulent by
the buyer.
(4) A sale by auction may be notified to be subject to a reserved or upset
price, and a right to bid may also be reserved expressly by or on behalf of the
seller.
(5) Where a right to bid is expressly reserved, but not otherwise, the seller, or any one person on his behalf, may bid at the auction.

60 Savings

(1) The rules in bankruptcy relating to contracts of sale shall continue to
apply to it, notwithstanding anything in this Act.
(2) The rules of the common law, including the law merchant, save in so
far as they are inconsistent with the express provisions of this Act, and in particular
the rules relating to the law of principal and agent, and the effect of fraud,
misrepresentation, duress or coercion, mistake, or other invalidating cause, shall
continue to apply to contracts for the sale of goods.
(3) The provisions of this Act relating to contracts of sale do not apply to
any transaction in the form of a contract of sale which is intended to operate by
way of mortgage, pledge, charge, or other security.
(4) Nothing in this Act shall affect the enactments in force relating to chattels
transfer, or any enactment in force relating to the sale of goods.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE [Not reproduced]

1563

SEAL OF NEW ZEALAND ACT 1977

1977/1 (NZ) – 28 February 1977

1

Short title

5

Validity of instruments

2

Assent of Parliament to establishment,

6

Judicial notice of Seal

design, and use of Seal of New Zealand

7-9 [Spent]

3

Use of Seal

4

Custody of Seal

SCHEDULE

To assent to the establishment, design, and use of a seal to be known as the

Seal of New Zealand and to provide for matters incidental

1 Short title

This is the Seal of New Zealand Act 1977.

2 Assent of Parliament to establishment, design, and use of Seal of New

Zealand

(1) The Parliament of New Zealand hereby assents to the establishment,
by Proclamation, from time to time by Her Majesty and Her successors of a seal to
be known as the Seal of New Zealand for use in relation to New Zealand and all
other territories for whose foreign relations Her Majesty’s Government in New
Zealand is responsible.
(2) The Seal of New Zealand shall be of such design and style as may be
specified in the Proclamation.
(3) No Proclamation made for the purposes of this section shall be required
to be sealed, and every such Proclamation that does not prescribe the time from
which it is to take effect shall come into operation on the day on which it is gazetted.

3 Use of Seal

(1) The Seal of New Zealand shall be the seal to be used on any instrument
that is made by Her Majesty and Her successors, or by the Governor-General, on
the advice of a Minister of Her Majesty’s Government in New Zealand or on the
advice and with the consent of the Executive Council of New Zealand.
(2) The Seal of New Zealand shall be so used in place of any other seal that
may have been so used if this Act had not been passed.
(3) The Seal of New Zealand in being at the time of the death of the
Sovereign shall continue and be made use of until provision for a new Seal of
New Zealand is made by Proclamation.
1564 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

4 Custody of Seal

The Seal of New Zealand shall be in the custody of the Governor-General.

5 Validity of instruments

(1) Except where the affixing of the Seal of New Zealand to any instrument
is expressly required by the provisions of any enactment other than this Act, no
instrument shall be declared or deemed invalid on the ground that it should have
been sealed with the Seal of New Zealand but has not been so sealed.
(2) No instrument shall be declared or deemed invalid on the ground that
it should not have been sealed with the Seal of New Zealand but has been so
sealed, or that the Seal of New Zealand has been improperly affixed to it.

6 Judicial notice of Seal

Judicial notice shall be taken by all Courts, Judges, Justices, Commissioners,
and other persons acting judicially of the impression of the Seal of New Zealand,
without evidence of such seal having been impressed or any other evidence relating
thereto.

7-9 [Spent]

––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE [Not reproduced]

1565

TERRITORIAL SEA AND EXCLUSIVE ECONOMIC ZONE ACT

1996

1997/220 – 7 April 1997

1 Short title

2 Interpretation

3 Reference to money amounts

PART 1

TERRITORIAL SEA

4 Territorial sea

5 Internal waters

6 Baseline of territorial sea

7 Foreshore, bed of internal waters, and

territorial sea vested in Crown

8 Official chart

9 Permanent harbour works

PART 2

EXCLUSIVE ECONOMIC ZONE

10 Exclusive Economic Zone

PART 3

APPLICATION

11 Application

PART 4

FISHERIES MANAGEMENT AND DEVELOPMENT

12 Designated fisheries

13 Management and development plans

14 Variation of management and

development plan

15 Exemptions

16 Revocation of management and

development plan

17 Offences

PART 5

UNAUTHORISED FISHING AND PROHIBITED FISHING

METHODS

18 Unauthorised fishing prohibited

19 Prohibited fishing methods

20 Driftnets and other equipment on board

vessels

21 Evidentiary certificate

21A Release of protected fish

PART 6

ACCESS AGREEMENTS

22 Access agreements

23 Licenses taken to have been issued under

this Act

24 Persons may act on behalf of the

Government of Niue in certain cases

25 Related agreements

PART 7

LICENSING

27 Application for licensed fishing craft

28 Issue of licenses

29 General conditions of licences

30 Variation and revocation of conditions

31 Statutory conditions

32 Term of licence

33 Authority to use fishing craft for certain

activities

34 Fees

35 Assignment of license or authorisation

36 Cancellation or suspension of licence

37 Appeals

PART 8

AUTHORISED OFFICERS AND OBSERVERS

38 Appointment of authorised officers

39 Power of authorised officers

40 Powers of authorised officers beyond limits

of fishery waters

41 Treatment of seized vessels

42 Removal of parts from seized vessels

43 Observers

44 Duties to authorised officers and observers

45 Identification of authorised officers and

observers

46 Protection of authorised officers, observers

and others

47 Information must be true, complete and

correct

1566 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 9 PART 10

SALE, RELEASE AND FORFEITURE OF RETAINED GENERAL PENALTY AND LIABILITY

PROPERTY 58 Liability of master

48 Release of seized goods 59 Penalties

49 Sale of perishable goods seized

50 Seized goods to be held PART 11

51 Court’s power of forfeiture REGULATIONS

52 Application of bond, security or proceeds 60 Regulations

of sale

53

Removal of forfeited goods

PART 12

54

Disposal of seized or forfeited goods

61-62

[Spent]

55

Liability for loss, damage or deterioration

of items in custody

56

Banning order

57

Removal of item in custody

To make provision with respect to the territorial sea of Niue and to establish an exclusive economic zone for Niue adjacent to the territorial sea, and in the exercise of the sovereign rights of Niue to make provision for the exploration and exploitation, and conservation and management of the resources of the zone, and related matters

1 Short title

This is the Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“access agreement” means an agreement under section 22 and includes
any other agreement or arrangement entered into under such an
agreement;
“authorised officer” means –
(a) The Director; or
(b) A fisheries officer; or
(c) A constable; or
(d) A surveillance officer; or
(e) A person appointed under section 38; or
(f) A person or body referred to in section 24;
“body corporate” means a body corporate resident on Niue;
“commercial fishing” means taking fish for sale;
“designated fishery” means any fishery designated under section 12;
“Director” means the Director of Agriculture, Forestry and Fisheries;
“driftnet” means a gillnet or other net which is more than 2.5 kilometres in
length, the purpose of which is to enmesh, entrap, or entangle fish;
“driftnet fishing” means fishing with a driftnet;
“exclusive economic zone” means the exclusive economic zone of Niue
described in section 10;
“fish” means any aquatic plant or animal, whether piscine or not, and
includes any oyster or other mollusc, crustacean (including uga), coral,
sponge, holothurian (beche-de-mer), or other echinoderm, turtle and
marine mammal, and include their eggs, spawn, spat and juvenile
stages;

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1567
“fisheries officer” means a fisheries officer appointed by the Niue Public
Service Commission and responsible to the Director;
“fishery” means one or more stocks of fish or any fishing operation based
on those stocks which can be created as a unit for the purposes of
conservation and management;
“fishery waters” means all –
(a) The internal waters of Niue (including lagoons);
(b) The territorial sea of Niue; and
(c) The exclusive economic zone;
“fishing” means activity that is either –
(a) Searching for, catching, taking or harvesting fish;
(b) The attempted searching for, catching, taking or harvesting of fish;
(c) Engaging in any activity which can reasonably be expected to result
in the locating, catching, taking or harvesting of fish;
(d) Placing, searching for or recovering any fish, aggregating device or
associated equipment including radio beacons;
(e) Fish processing within the fishery waters;
(f) Transshipment within the fishery waters;
(g) Any operation at sea in support of or in preparation for any activity
described in this paragraph;
(h) The use of any fishing craft in relation to any activity described in
this definition;
(i) Any related activity; or
(j) The use of any vehicle, vessel or aircraft, for any activity described
in this paragraph, except for emergencies involving the health or
safety of crew members or the safety of the vessel;
“fishing craft” means any vessel, aircraft, hovercraft, submersible craft, or
other craft, of whatever size, that is capable of being used for fishing
but, shall not include any vessel that is 5 metres or less in overall length;
“fishing gear” means any equipment, implement, or other thing that can
be used in the act of fishing, including any fishing net, rope, line, float,
trap, hook, winch, fishing craft or vessel;
“fish processing” means the producing of any substance or article from
fish by any method and includes the cutting up, dismembering,
cleaning, sorting, loining, freezing, canning, salting and preserving of
fish;
“fish processing establishment” means a place (other than a licensed fishing
craft) where fish are canned, dried, gutted, salted, iced, chilled, frozen
or otherwise processed for sale on or outside Niue;
“foreshore” means all the land between the high water line at mean-high
water spring tides and the low water line at mean-low-water spring
tides;
Gazette” means any periodical printed publication circulating in Niue such
as the Niue Star;
“highly migratory species” means species that, in the course of their life
cycle, migrate over great distances of ocean;
“low-water mark” has the meaning assigned to it by section 8(1);
“master”, in relation to any fishing craft, means the person for the time
being having command or charge, or apparent command or charge of
the craft;
1568 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“median line” as between Niue and any other country, means a line every point of which is equidistant from the nearest points of the baseline of the territorial sea of Niue and the corresponding baseline of that other country;
“Minister” means the Minister responsible for fisheries; “nautical mile” means the international nautical mile;
“Niuean” includes a person having the status of permanent resident as defined in the Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985 and its Regulations;
“observer” means any person authorised to act as an observer under section
38 and includes any person who has any or all of the functions, powers
and duties of an observer under an access agreement;
“observer device” means any device or machine placed on a fishing craft
in accordance with this Act or an access agreement which transmits
(whether in conjunction with other machines elsewhere or not),
information or data concerning the position of fishing activities of the
fishing craft;
“operator” in relation to any fishing craft includes any body of persons,
whether incorporated or not, by whom the craft is operated, and any
owner, charterer, master, lessee, or sub-lessee who exercises control over
any of the fishing activities of the craft;
“owner”, in relation to a fishing craft, includes any person or body of
persons whether incorporated or not, by whom the craft is owned, and
any charterer, sub-charter, lessee or sub-lessee;
“prescribed” means prescribed by regulations made under this Act;
“protected fish species” means the species of fish the Government of Niue
recognises as fish that are to be protected within Niue’s territorial sea
and exclusive economic zone such as –
(i) Cetaceans; all species of whales identified within/under the 3
groups Right Whale, Grey Whale, and Rorquals;
(ii) Cetaceans; All species of whales identified within/under the 5
groups Sperm Whale, Beaked Whale, Belugas Whale, Narwhal,
and Dolphin and Porpoise;
(iii) All marine species of the Chelonia order which, includes all
species of Turtle;
(iv) Myliobatdidae; rays, all species; and
(v) Lamniformes; sharks, all species;
“Regional register” means the Regional Register of Foreign Fishing Vessels
maintained by the South Pacific Forum Fisheries Agency at Honiara,
Solomon Islands;
“related activity” means doing anything in support of, or in preparation
for, fishing operations, including doing, or attempting or preparing to
do or having done any of the following –
(a) Transshipping fish; or
(b) Storing, processing or transporting fish at any time before the fish
is or are brought on land; or
(c) Refuelling or supplying fishing craft; or
(d) Performing activities in support of fishing operations;
“surveillance officer” means any officer of a vessel or aircraft used for the
enforcement of this Act, whether or not the officer is a Niuean and
whether or not the vessel or aircraft is registered in Niue;
“territorial sea” means the area of the sea defined in section 4;

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1569
“transshipment” means transferring any fish or fish product to or from one fishing craft to another;
“vessel” means any boat, ship or other water-going craft.
(2) The administration of this Act is under the control and direction of
Cabinet, which may delegate, either generally or particularly all or any of the
powers conferred on it under this Act.

3 Reference to money amounts

(1) A reference in this Act or the regulations to any penalty or fee, the amount
of which is specified, or to any other specified amount of money, is to be read as a
reference to the specified amount in the currency of the United States of America.
(2) A reference in this Act or the regulations to a penalty or fee, the amount
of which is not specified, or to any other unspecified amount of money, is to be
read as empowering the person or body authorised to specify the amount to do so
in the currency of the United States of America.

4 Territorial sea

PART 1
TERRITORIAL SEA
The territorial sea of Niue comprises those areas of the sea having, as their inner limits, the baseline described in section 6 and, as their outer limits, a line measured seaward from that baseline, every point of which is distant 12 nautical miles from the nearest point of the baseline.

5 Internal waters

The internal waters of Niue include any areas of the sea that are on the
landward side of the baseline of the territorial sea of Niue.

6 Baseline of territorial sea

The baseline from which the breadth of the territorial sea is measured shall
be the low-water mark along the coast of Niue or where there is a coral reef along
any part of the coast of Niue, the low-water mark along the outer edge of the coral
reef.

7 Foreshore, bed of internal waters, and territorial sea vested in Crown

(1) The seabed and subsoil of the submarine areas of the internal waters of
Niue are, and are taken always to have been, vested in the Crown.
(2) The foreshore of Niue and 10 metres inland from the foreshore and the
seabed and subsoil of the territorial sea are, and are taken always to have been
vested in the Crown.

8 Official chart

(1) For the purposes of this Act, the low-water mark in a particular area is
the line of low water at mean low-water spring tides as shown on the largest scale
British Admiralty chart for the time being of that area.
(2) In any proceedings in a court, a certificate purporting to be signed by
an officer of the New Zealand Naval Forces authorised by the Secretary of Defence
or a Deputy Secretary of Defence, stating that a specified chart of a specified area
is the largest scale British Admiralty Chart for the time being of that area is
admissible as evidence of the matters stated in the certificate.
1570 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

9 Permanent harbour works

For the purposes of this Act, permanent harbour works forming an integral
part of a harbour system are taken to form part of the coast of Niue.
PART 2
EXCLUSIVE ECONOMIC ZONE

10 Exclusive Economic Zone

(1) The exclusive economic zone of Niue comprises those areas of the sea,
seabed and subsoil that are beyond and adjacent to the territorial sea having as
their outer limits a line measured seaward from the baseline described in section
6, every point of which line is distant 200 nautical miles from the nearest point of
the baseline.
(2) Notwithstanding subsection (1), where any part of the median line
between Niue and any other country is less than 200 nautical miles from the nearest
part of the baseline of the territorial sea of Niue that part of the median line shall
be an outer limit of the zone.

11 Application

PART 3
APPLICATION
(1) This Act applies to every person, every fishing craft and every vessel, fishing within fishery waters.
(2) No fishing craft shall be used for commercial fishing unless the craft is licensed under section 28.
PART 4
FISHERIES MANAGEMENT AND DEVELOPMENT

12 Designated fisheries

If Cabinet thinks it is in the national interest to ensure the effective
conservation or the efficient use of a fishery, it may, by notice in the Gazette declare
the fishery to be a designated fishery.

13 Management and development plans

(1) The Director may direct a Fisheries Officer to prepare and implement a
management and development plan for a designated fishery.
(2) The management and development plan shall –
(a) Identify the fishery to which it relates; and
(b) Set out the objectives to be achieved by the plan; and
(c) Specify the management measures to be adopted to achieve those
objectives; and
(d) Specify what protection is to be given to the habitat of the fishery;
and
(e) Specify the limits within which the fishery may be exploited; and
(f) Specify what licensing requirements (if any) are to apply to anyone
who wants to operate within a fishery; and
(g) Specify what protection is to be given to any other designated fishery
(whether by way of management measures, habitat protection,
exploitation limits or licensing requirements) for the purpose of –
(i) Ensuring the conservation of the fishery in accordance with its
management and development plan; or
(ii) Ensuring that the objectives set out in the management and
development plan can be achieved;
(h) Identify new protected fish species.

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1571

14 Variation of management and development plan

(1) If the Director thinks that a management and development plan should
be varied in order to ensure the effective conservation or the efficient use of the
fishery to which it relates, the Director may, in writing, prepare a variation of the
plan and submit it to Cabinet for approval.
(2) A variation takes effect when it is approved by Cabinet or at such other
time as Cabinet determines.

15 Exemptions

(1) Cabinet may, on application made by or on behalf of a person or a
group of persons, declare that a management and development plan, or a specified
part of such a plan, is not to apply to the person or group.
(2) Cabinet may make a declaration subject to such conditions, if any, as
Cabinet thinks necessary in order to ensure the effective conservation or efficient
use of the fishery to which the management and development plan relates.

16 Revocation of management and development plan

If Cabinet is satisfied that the objectives set out in a management and
development plan have been achieved, the Cabinet may revoke the plan by notice
in the Gazette.

17 Offences

(1) A person may not contravene or fail to comply with a provision of a
management and development plan that applies to the person.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 1,000 penalty units.
(2) A person must not contravene or fail to comply with a direction given
to the person by an authorised officer, being a direction that is consistent with a
management and development plan, or part of such a plan, that applies to the
person.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 1,000 penalty units.
(3) In this section, person includes a Niuean and a resident of Niue.
PART 5
UNAUTHORISED FISHING AND PROHIBITED FISHING METHODS

18 Unauthorised fishing prohibited

(1) A person shall not engage in commercial fishing in fishery waters unless
the person is licensed, authorised or otherwise permitted to do so by or under this
Act or the regulations.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 1,000 penalty units and the Court may order the
confiscation of fishing gear.
(2) A fishing craft shall not –
(a) Do anything in fishery waters that is not authorised or permitted
by or under international law; or
(b) Be used for fishing in fishery waters unless it is licensed, authorised
or otherwise permitted to do so by or under this Act or the
regulations.
(3) A fishing craft shall not, while in any area within fishery waters, carry
any fishing gear that is stored in a way that would allow it to be made readily
available for fishing in that area, unless the vessel is licensed for use for fishing in
that area or such use otherwise authorised or permitted by or under this Act or
the regulations.
1572 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(4) If a fishing craft contravenes subsection (2) or (3), the owner or charterer and the master of the vessel are each guilty of an offence.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 5,000 penalty units and the Court may order confiscation of fishing gear.

19 Prohibited fishing methods

(1) A person shall not –
(a) Have control or possession of a driftnet; or
(b) Engage in driftnet fishing in fishery waters; or
(c) Use any explosives, poison or other noxious substance for the
purpose of killing, stunning, disabling or catching fish in fishery
waters; or
(d) Bring on land, sell, dispose of, receive or have possession of any
fish caught in contravention of paragraph (b) or (c).
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 100 penalty units.
(2) If a contravention of subsection (1) occurs on board a vessel or by use
of a vessel, the owner or charterer, and the master, of the vessel is each guilty of an
offence.
Penalty: 2,500 penalty units and the Court may order confiscation of fishing gear.

20 Driftnets and other equipment on board vessels

(1) If a driftnet is found on board a vessel, then, for the purpose of any
proceedings under section 19 –
(a) The driftnet is taken to be in the possession and control of the owner
or charterer, and of the master of the vessel; and
(b) The vessel is taken to have been used for the purpose of driftnet
fishing in fishery waters; and
(c) Fish on board the vessel are taken to have been caught in fishery
waters by driftnet fishing.
(2) If an explosive, poison or other noxious substance is found on board a
vessel that is used mainly for the purpose of fishing the explosive, poison or
substance is to be presumed, unless the contrary is proved to be intended for use
in contravention of section 19 (1)(c).

21 Evidentiary certificate

In any proceedings for an offence against section 19, a certificate signed by
an authorised officer stating the cause and manner of death or injury of specified
fish, or the circumstances surrounding the alleged commission of the offence, is
evidence of the matter stated in the certificate.

21A Release of protected fish

(1) Any person who catches a protected fish species must release the fish
unharmed where caught.
(2) Any person who fails to comply with subsection (1) commits an offence
and is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1000 penalty units.

22 Access agreements

PART 6
ACCESS AGREEMENTS
(1) The Minister may, with Cabinet’s approval, enter into a bilateral or multilateral access agreement on behalf of the Government of Niue with the government or governments of one or more other countries.

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1573
(2) An access agreement may provide for vessels owned or controlled by the country concerned, or by its nationals –
(a) To be licensed for use in fishing in fishery waters and have access to those waters for that purpose; and
(b) Engage in any other related activities.
(3) The Minister may, in entering into access agreements, grant preferential
access to vessels owned or controlled by member countries of the South Pacific
Forum Fisheries Agency.
(4) Every access agreement must –
(a) Provide for fishing allocations at a level consistent with the proper
conservation and management of fishery resources; and
(b) Be consistent with any relevant management and development plan;
and
(c) Provide for the proper protection of fishing by Niueans; and
(d) Require the other parties to the agreement to take all necessary steps
to ensure that the vessels covered by the agreement comply with
the terms of the agreement and with the applicable laws of Niue;
and
(e) Require the transshipment of fish at a time and place authorised by
the licensing authority under the agreement except in cases where
a licensed group seiner carries out transshipment to its licensed
carrier vessel with the prior approval of the licensing authority;
and
(f) Require the master of each vessel covered by the agreement to
maintain fishing data about fishing carried out using the vessel on
the high seas adjacent to the fishery waters, and to report that data
in the prescribed form and manner to the Fisheries Officer; and
(g) Provide for the issuing of licences for fishing in fishery waters, or
in a specified part of those waters, on terms and conditions
consistent with this Act.

23 Licences taken to have been issued under this Act

A licence, or authorisation issued or granted under an access agreement is,
for the purposes of this Act, taken to have been issued or granted under this Act.

24 Persons may act on behalf of the Government of Niue in certain cases

(1) A multilateral access agreement may authorise a person or body to act
on behalf of the Government of Niue, or to act on its behalf in the performance of
any obligations, duties or responsibilities (including the issue of licences).
(2) Any act done by any person, on behalf of the Government of Niue
under an authority given in a multilateral access agreement is taken to have been
done by the Government of Niue.

25 Certain provisions to have no effect

A provision in an access agreement has no effect if it –
(a) Purports to operate in substitution of this Act; or
(b) Purports to prevent the Government of Niue from enforcing
compliance with any provision of the access agreement; or
(c) Purports to prevent the Government of Niue from taking
proceedings under this Act against any person in respect of any
fishing activity not authorised by the agreement.
1574 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

26 Related agreements

(1) The Minister may, with Cabinet’s approval, enter into any other
agreement that may be appropriate for the promotion of fisheries co-operation
and harmonisation between Niue and any other country or countries.
(2) Without limiting subsection (1), the agreements referred to in that
subsection could include, for example, agreements relating to –
(a) The harmonisation of minimum terms and conditions for access to
fisheries; or
(b) The implementation of multilateral access agreements; or
(c) The establishment of harmonised joint or reciprocal fisheries
surveillance and enforcement measures;
(d) The harmonisation of joint exploration and development of
fisheries; or
(e) The development of observer programmes; or
(f) The harmonisation of transshipment requirements; or
(g) The harmonisation of fisheries conservation and management.
PART 7
LICENSING

27 Application for licensed fishing craft

(1) An application for a licence for a fishing craft may be made by or on
behalf of the owner or charterer of the craft.
(2) An application must be in writing and lodged with the Director. It must
include the following particulars –
(a) The fishing craft’s name, international radio call sign, specifications
and country of registration;
(b) The name of the owner or charterer, and the master, of the vessel;
(c) The fishery resources to be exploited and the period during which
exploitation is expected to occur;
(d) The term for which the licence is sought;
(e) The allocation of the fishery resources sought;
(f) The desired area of the fishery waters within which the exploitation
is to be carried out;
(g) The method to be used to exploit the fishery resource;
(h) The way in which the catch or harvest is to be disposed of, including
particulars of the port where this is to occur and a statement
indicating whether the catch or harvest is to be processed and, if
so, in what form;
(i) The estimated costs of exploiting the fishery resources and the
estimated amount of the revenue to be derived from the exploitation;
(j) Such other matters, if any, as are prescribed.
(3) An application must also include statements indicating –
(a) Whether the vessel has at any time contravened an access agreement
(whether the Government of Niue is a party or not), and, if so, the
nature of the contravention and the action taken or the penalty
imposed as a consequence; and
(b) Whether the vessel is the subject of an inquiry or investigation
relating to an alleged contravention of such an access agreement
and, if so, the nature of the allegation; and
(c) Whether the vessel is subject to any encumbrance, charge, lien,
mortgage or liability whether potential, or actual, and whether or
not arising out of any inquiry, investigation or legal proceeding;
and

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1575
(d) Whether the vessel has been denied approval to fish in the waters of any other country and, if so, the reasons for the denial; and
(e) Whether the vessel has had its approval to fish in the waters of any other country suspended or withdrawn and, if so, the reasons for the suspension or withdrawal.
(4) An application must also include statements indicating –
(a) Whether the owner, charterer or master of the vessel has
contravened any access agreement (whether the government of
Niue is party or not) and, if so, the nature of the contravention; and
(b) Whether the owner, charterer or master of the vessel is alleged to
have contravened such an access agreement and if so, the nature of
the allegation; and
(c) Whether the owner, charterer or master of the vessel is or has been
involved in an inquiry, investigation or legal proceeding as a
consequence of being engaged in fishing in the waters of any other
country, and, if so particulars of that involvement; and
(d) Whether the owner, charterer or master of the vessel has incurred
any unsatisfied liability or penalty or may incur any liability or
penalty, arising out of any contravention, inquiry, investigation or
proceeding mentioned in paragraph (a), (b) or (c); and
(e) Whether the owner, charterer or master of the vessel has engaged
or is alleged to have engaged, in driftnet fishing.

28 Issue of licences

(1) The Minister may, on an application made under section 27 and with
Cabinet’s approval, issue a licence permitting a fishing craft identified in the application to be used –
(a) For fishing (including test fishing) in the fishery waters; and
(b) For scientific research in the fishery waters.
(2) The Minister may issue a licence in respect of a fishing craft whether or
not the fishing craft is covered by an access agreement which is in force.
(3) A licence shall –
(a) Specify the particular fishing activity permitted by it; and
(b) Provide fishing allocations at a level consistent with the proper
conservation and management of fishery resources; and
(c) Be consistent with any relevant management and development plan;
and
(d) Ensure the protection of fishing by Niueans.
(4) In approving a licence, the Cabinet may impose any special conditions
that it thinks desirable to ensure the proper conservation and management of
fishery resources, including, for example, conditions relating to the following –
(a) The type and method of fishing;
(b) The area within which fishing is permitted;
(c) The target species and quantity of fish authorised to be caught,
including restrictions on by-catches;
(d) The term of the licence.
(5) The Cabinet must not approve a licence unless satisfied that it ensures
appropriate protection of fishing by Niueans.
(6) A licence must not be issued to a fishing craft under this section, unless
that fishing craft is in good standing on the Regional Register.
1576 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(7) If a fishing craft is not registered on the Regional Register a licence may nevertheless be issued to a fishing craft that is fully owned or controlled by –
(a) The Government of Niue; or
(b) A Niuean; or
(c) A person resident in Niue.
(8) In this section –
“test fishing” means fishing for the purpose of testing the feasibility of
commercial fishing;
“scientific fishing” means gathering data for the purpose of conserving or
managing a fishery.

29 General conditions of licences

(1) The Cabinet may, by notice in the Gazette, specify general conditions
applicable to all licences.
(2) A general condition is taken to come into operation on a date specified
in the notice or, if no date is specified, on the day on which it is published in the

Gazette.

(3) General conditions applicable to all licences, whether or not an access
agreement is in effect, may include, for example, conditions relating to the
following –
(a) Open and closed fishing seasons;
(b) Prohibited fishing areas;
(c) Minimum mesh size of fishing nets;
(d) Minimum fish size;
(e) Observer devices;
(f) Any other general conditions as required by Cabinet.
(4) Any person who, whether intentionally or unintentionally, destroys,
damages, renders inoperative or otherwise interferes with an observer device
aboard a fishing craft without first obtaining the approval of the Director, commits
an offence.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units.

30 Variation and revocation of conditions

(1) Cabinet may, if satisfied that it is necessary to do so to ensure the proper
conservation or management of fishery resources, add to, vary or revoke any special
or general conditions imposed under this Act.
(2) A general condition must be varied or revoked by notice in the Gazette.
(3) If Cabinet adds a new general condition, it must do so by notice in the

Gazette.

(4) If Cabinet adds a new special condition or varies or revokes a special
condition, it must cause the holder of the licence concerned to be notified
accordingly.

31 Statutory conditions

Every licence issued under Part 7 is subject to the following conditions –
(a) The owner or charterer, and the master of the fishing craft to which
the licence applies must comply with the laws of Niue;
(b) The performance by the fishing craft to which the licence relates
must at all times be consistent with the information, and financial
projections, given in the application for the licence.

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1577

32 Term of licence

(1) Subject to this Act and any special or general conditions imposed by or
under this Act, the term of a licence issued under Part 7 shall be for a period of one
year from the date the licence is issued.
(2) A licence issued under this Act may be renewed on application made
under section 27 before the end of the latest term of the licence.

33 Authority to use fishing craft for certain activities

(1) The Director may, with Cabinet’s approval, authorise the use of a fishing
craft for a specified fishing activity within fishery waters.
(2) An authorisation may be made subject to such conditions, if any, as the
Cabinet determines.
(3) The Director must not grant an authorisation under this section unless
satisfied –
(a) That it would not be appropriate in the circumstances to require a licence to be issued permitting the fishing craft to be used for the relevant activity; and
(b) That the activity will not involve catching fish; and
(c) That the activity will not be continuing one.

34 Fees

(1) There shall be a fee payable for every licence issued and for
authorisations granted under this Act, provided however, where an access
agreement specifies the making of such payments no additional payment shall be
required.
(2) Cabinet shall prescribe the fees payable for the issue of licences and
shall determine the amount payable for the granting of an authorisation.

35 Assignment of licence or authorisation

(1) A licence or authorisation issued or granted under this Act is not
transferable, except with Cabinet’s approval or under an access agreement.
(2) Any provision in a contract or arrangement that purports to assign,
transfer or dispose of all or any of the rights or benefits conferred by a licence or
authorisation issued or granted under this Act is void.
(3) Each person who enters into an agreement or arrangement that contains
a provision of the kind described in subsection (2) is guilty of an offence.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 1,000 penalty units.
(4) For the purpose of this section, the charter of a fishing craft in respect
of which a licence or authorisation has been issued or granted under this Act, is
taken to be a transfer of the licence or authorisation.

36 Cancellation or suspension of licence

(1) Cabinet may cancel a licence issued under this Act, or suspend such a
licence for the period determined by Cabinet if –
(a) The licence is, or becomes, inconsistent with the requirements of a
management and development plan; or
(b) The fishing craft in respect of which it is issued, or the owner,
charterer or the master of the fishing craft, has contravened –
(i) A provision of this Act; or
(ii) A condition of the licence; or
(iii) If the licence was issued under an access agreement, a provision
of the agreement; or
1578 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(c) A payment due under, or in respect of, the licence is outstanding;
or
(d) The fishing craft’s good standing on the Regional Register is
suspended or withdrawn; or
(e) The fishing craft, or the owner, charterer or master of the fishing
craft has been engaged in driftnet fishing; or
(f) There is a driftnet on board the fishing craft.
(2) The owner, charterer, or the master, of a fishing craft whose licence is
cancelled or suspended must be notified of the cancellation or suspension in
accordance with the Cabinet’s directions.
(3) A cancellation or suspension takes effect when the notice referred to in
subsection (2) is given.
(4) If a licence is cancelled or suspended on the ground mentioned in
subsection (1) (a) any fee paid in respect of the issue of the licence must be
apportioned, and the amount that represents the unexpired part of the term of the
licence worked out on a pro rata basis, must be reimbursed to the person who
paid the fee.

37 Appeals

A person aggrieved by a decision of the Cabinet to cancel or suspend a
licence may, within 21 days after the cancellation or suspension takes effect, appeal
to a Judge of the Court against the decision.
PART 8
AUTHORISED OFFICERS AND OBSERVERS

38 Appointment of authorised officers

(1) The Minister may, by notice in the Gazette, appoint a person, or each
person in a class of persons (including a national or nationals of another country),
to be an authorised officer for the purposes of this Act.
(2) The Minister may direct than an authorised officer shall not be an
employee of the Public Service Commission.

39 Powers of authorised officers

(1) For the purposes of enforcing this Act, an authorised officer may,
without a warrant do any of the following –
(a) Stop, board and search any fishing craft to which this Act applies
that the officer reasonably suspects has contravened or is
contravening this Act;
(b) Stay on board that fishing craft;
(c) Require the master or anyone else on board to tell the officer the
fishing craft’s name, call sign and country of registration and the
name of the master, owner, charterer or other crew member;
(d) Require the master or anyone else on board, to answer questions
about the fishing craft’s cargo, the contents of its holds and storage
spaces, and its voyage and activities;
(e) Make any examination and inquiry that the officer thinks necessary
about any premises, vessel, vehicle or aircraft in relation to which
any of the powers conferred by this section have been or may be
exercised, and take samples of any fish or fish product found in or
on the premises, vessel, vehicle or aircraft;
(f) Examine and take copies of any licence, logbook, record or other
document that is required under this Act or that concerns the
operation of any fishing craft;

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1579
(g) Make, date and sign an entry in the fishing craft’s log;
(h) Examine any fish, fishing gear or explosive, poison or other noxious
substance in or on any premises, vessel, vehicle or aircraft;
(i) Give any directions to the master or to a crew member of any fishing
craft stopped, boarded or searched that may be necessary or
reasonably expedient for any purpose specified in this Act, or to
provide for the compliance of the fishing craft or master or any
crew member with the conditions of any licence, authority,
permission or approval given or issued under this Act;
(j) Examine any observer device;
(k) Require the master of a fishing craft, or a person apparently in charge
of any premises, vehicle or aircraft, to produce to the officer any
thing mentioned in paragraph (f), (h) or (j) that is in or on the fishing
craft, premises, vehicle or aircraft.
(2) Where an authorised officer has reasonable grounds to believe an
offence against this Act is being or has been committed, he may without a warrant –
(a) Enter, inspect and search any premises, other than premises used
exclusively as a dwelling-house, in which he has reasonable grounds
to believe an offence has been or is being committed or fish taken
illegally are being stored;
(b) Stop, enter and search, and stay in or on any vehicle or aircraft
which he reasonably suspects of transporting fish or fish products;
(c) Following hot pursuit in accordance with international law and
commenced within the fisheries waters, stop, board and search
outside the fisheries waters any vessel which he has reasonable
grounds to believe has been used in the commission of any offence
and bring that vessel and all persons and things on board within
the fisheries waters;
(d) Seize –
(i) Any vessel (together with its fishing gear, equipment, stores
and cargo), vehicle or aircraft which he has reasonable grounds
to believe has been or is being used in the commission of an
offence or which he knows or has reasonable grounds to believe
has been seized or forfeited under this Act;
(ii) Any fish or fish products which he has reasonable grounds to
believe have been caught in the commission of an offence or
are possessed in contravention of this Act;
(iii) Any logs, charts or other documents required to be maintained
by this Act or under the terms of any licence or permit or which
he has reasonable grounds to believe show or tend to show,
with or without other evidence, the commission of an offence
against this Act;
(iv) Anything which he has reasonable grounds to believe might
be used as evidence in any proceedings under this Act; and
(e) Arrest any person whom he has reasonable grounds to believe has
committed an offence against this Act.
(3) An authorised officer may, with or without a warrant or other process –
(a) Execute any warrant or other process issued by any court of
competent jurisdiction; and
(b) Exercise any other lawful authority.
1580 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

40 Powers of authorised officers beyond limits of fishery waters

If a vessel in hot pursuit is beyond the limits of the fishery waters, the
powers conferred on authorised officers under this Act may be exercised beyond
the limits of the fishery waters under international law.

41 Treatment of seized vessels

(1) If a fishing craft is seized under this Act –
(a) The master and crew must take it to the nearest or most convenient
port designated by the authorised officer; and
(b) The master is responsible for the safety of the fishing craft and
everyone on board the fishing craft, until the fishing craft arrives at
the designated port.
(2) If the master does not take the seized fishing craft to the designated
port, an authorised officer, or person called upon to assist the officer may do so.
(3) If a fishing craft is brought to port in the circumstances described in
subsection (2), no claim whatever may be made against an authorised officer or
the Government of Niue in respect of any death, injury, loss or damage incurred
while the vessel is being taken to the designated port.
(4) The provisions of subsections (1), (2) and (3) apply (with the necessary
changes) to vehicles and aircraft seized under this Act, and their drivers and pilots
respectively.
(5) The owner and operator shall pay the costs of any environmental
damage, cleaning, disposal or removal of fishing craft from Niue’s exclusive
economic zone.

42 Removal of parts from seized vessels

(1) An authorised officer may remove any part or parts from any fishing
craft held in the custody of the Government of Niue for the purpose of immobilising
the fishing craft.
(2) The authorised officer who removes a part or parts under subsection
(1) must ensure that the part or parts are kept safely and returned to the fishing
craft on its lawful release from custody.
(3) A person must not –
(a) Possess or arrange to obtain any part or parts removed under
subsection (1), except for the purposes of keeping the part or parts
safely under subsection (2); or
(b) Possess or arrange to obtain or make any replacement or substitute
part or parts for those removed under subsection (1); or
(c) Fit any part or parts or any replacement or substitute part or parts
to a fishing craft, held in the custody of the Government of Niue.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units.

43 Observers

(1) The Director may designate, in writing, one or more persons to act as
observers on fishing craft in respect of which a licence or authorisation has been
issued or granted under this Act.
(2) An access agreement may confer on a person the powers and duties of
an observer and may confer powers and duties on the person in addition to those
conferred by this section.
(3) An observer may board any fishing craft in respect of which a licence
or authorisation has been granted under this Act for the purpose of –

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1581
(a) Ensuring compliance by the fishing craft and its crew with this Act and the terms and conditions of the licence or authorisation; or
(b) Monitoring any of the fishing craft’s activities; or
(c) Undertaking any research determined by the Director.
(4) The operator, and each member of the crew, of the fishing craft must
allow and assist an observer to exercise all or any of the following powers –
(a) To board the fishing craft;
(b) To gain full access to, and use of any of the facilities and equipment
on the fishing craft that the observer thinks necessary to carry out
his duties;
(c) To gain full access to the bridge and to areas which may be used to
hold, weigh and store fish;
(d) To gain full access to the fishing craft’s records (including its log)
and gather any information he requires relating to fisheries in fishery
waters;
(e) To gain full access to any fish on the fishing craft and to take samples
of them;
(f) To inspect and copy the fishing craft’s records (including its logs);
(g) To disembark at the time and place determined by the Director or
under an access agreement.
(5) The operator must provide the observer, while on board the fishing
craft and at no expense to the Government of Niue, with food, accommodation
and medical facilities as may be reasonably acceptable to the Director.
(6) An observer may enter in or on any place where fish taken in the fishery
waters is unloaded or transshipped, and may remove samples and gather any
information he requires relating to fisheries in the fishery waters.

44 Duties to authorised officers and observers

(1) The master and each crew member of any fishing craft, the driver of
any vehicle and the pilot and crew of any aircraft must comply immediately with every lawful instruction or direction given by an authorised officer or an observer. (2) The master and each crew member of a fishing craft, driver of a vehicle
and pilot and crew of an aircraft must take all reasonable measures –
(a) To ensure the safety of an authorised officer or observer in the
performance of his duties; and
(b) To assist the officer or observer in the performance of those duties
or the exercise of any of his powers.
(3) A person must not –
(a) Assault, obstruct, resist, delay, intimidate or otherwise interfere with
an authorised officer or observer in the performance of his duties;
or
(b) Assault, obstruct, resist, delay, intimidate or otherwise interfere with
anyone lawfully acting under the orders, or in aid of, an authorised
officer; or
(c) Threaten, insult or use abusive language or insulting gestures
towards any authorised officer or observer while performing his
duties or exercising his powers; or
(d) Threaten, insult or use abusive language or threatening gestures
towards any one lawfully acting under the orders, or in aid of an
authorised officer; or
(e) Fail to comply with the lawful requirements of any authorised officer
or observer; or
1582 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(f) Give an authorised officer any particulars which the person knows are false or misleading in a material respect; or
(g) Impersonates or falsely represents himself to be an authorised officer, or falsely represents himself to be a person lawfully acting under an authorised officer ’s orders or in his aid.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units or imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 2 months or both.

45 Identification of authorised officers and observers

An authorised officer or observer, when exercising any of the powers
conferred by this Act, must, if asked to do so, produce identification to show he is
an authorised officer or observer under this Act.

46 Protection of authorised officers, observers and others

An action or other proceeding (whether civil or criminal) does not lie against
a person in relation to any thing done, or not done, by the person in good faith in
the performance or exercise, or purported performance or exercise of the person’s
functions or powers under this Act.

47 Information must be true, complete and correct

(1) A person required to record, notify, communicate or report any
information under this Act must ensure that any information so recorded, notified
or communicated is true, complete and correct.
(2) A person required to notify, communicate or report any information to
the Director by or under this Act or the regulations must notify the Director
immediately of any change in circumstances which has the effect of rendering
any information previously notified, communicated or reported false, incomplete
or misleading.
(3) A person who contravenes this section commits an offence.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units.
PART 9
SALE, RELEASE AND FORFEITURE OF RETAINED PROPERTY

48 Release of seized goods

(1) The Court, may on application, order the release of any fishing craft
(together with its fishing gear, equipment, stores and cargo), vehicle, aircraft or
other item seized under this Act on receipt of a bond or other form of security.
(2) In determining the value of the bond or other form of security, the Court
must take into consideration –
(a) The total value of the property to be released, including the value
of any catch which might be forfeited;
(b) The total maximum fine or fines provided for the offences charged
or likely to be charged; and
(c) The costs the prosecution would be likely to recover if a conviction
were entered.

49 Sale of perishable goods seized

(1) Any fish or other items of a perishable nature seized under this Act, or
the proceeds of sale of the fish or items, must be held and dealt with under this
Act.
(1).
(2) The Director may sell the fish or other items referred to in subsection

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1583
(3) If the Director, after making all reasonable efforts, is unable to sell the fish or other items referred to in subsection (1), or if the fish or other items are unfit for sale, the Director may dispose of them in such manner as he thinks fit.

50 Seized goods to be held

The Government of Niue must hold anything seized under this Act, and
any bond or security and the proceeds of sale, until –
(a) Any relevant legal proceedings under this Act have been finally
dealt with; or
(b) A decision is made not to start any such proceedings.

51 Court’s power of forfeiture

(1) If a person is convicted of an offence against this Act, the Court, in
addition to any other penalty may order –
(a) That any fishing craft (together with its fishing gear, equipment,
stores and cargo) and any vehicle or aircraft used in the commission
of that offence be forfeited to the Crown; and
(b) That any fish or perishables caught or involved in the commission
of the offence, or the proceeds of sale of the fish or perishables, and
any explosive, poison or other noxious substance used or involved
in the commission of the offence, be forfeited.
(2) Where a fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft or other item seized under this
Act, or any bond, security or the proceeds of a sale, is not forfeited or applied in
the discharge of any fine, order for costs or penalty imposed under this Act, it
must be made available for collection by its owner or his nominee or, in the absence
of those persons, the person who appears to be entitled to it.
(3) If a fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft or other item has been released upon
the lodging of a bond or security, an order for forfeiture operates as an order for
forfeiture of the amount of the bond or security, unless the court for special reasons
fixes a smaller sum.
(4) If a fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft or other item has been released upon
the lodging of a bond or security, the Court may order any defendant convicted
of an offence against this Act involving the fishing craft, vehicle or aircraft or item
or the owner of the fishing craft, vehicle or aircraft or item concerned (whether or
not the owner is a defendant) to pay the difference between the amount of the
bond or security and the total value of the forfeited property as determined under
section 54.

52 Application of bond, security or proceeds of sale

A bond or security, or the proceeds of sale, must be applied in the following
order –
(a) First, in paying the costs associated with the sale (if any);
(b) Secondly, in discharging any forfeiture ordered under section 51;
(c) Thirdly, in paying all fines or penalties imposed under this Act in
connection with the fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft, or item;
(d) Fourthly, in discharging all orders for costs in proceedings under
this Act arising out of relating to the fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft;
(e) Finally, in making such other payments (if any) as the Court
determines.

53 Removal of forfeited goods

If a fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft or other item held or forfeited under this
Act has been unlawfully removed from the custody of the Government of Niue it
is liable to seizure.
1584 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

54 Disposal of seized or forfeited goods

(1) A fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft or other item ordered to be forfeited
under this Act may, at the expiry of the time limited for appeal and if no appeal is
lodged, be disposed of in such manner as Cabinet may direct.
(2) A fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft or other item seized under this Act but
not forfeited must be sold and the proceeds disposed of in the manner and the
priority specified in section 52.

55 Liability for loss, damage or deterioration of items in custody

The Government of Niue is not liable for any loss of, damage to or
deterioration in the condition of any fishing craft, vehicle, aircraft or other item
while in the custody of the government of Niue under this Act.

56 Banning order

(1) If a person is convicted of an offence against section 44 (3), the court
may, in addition to imposing any penalty, make an order banning the person for a
period not exceeding 5 years from going on or remaining on board any fishing
craft while the fishing craft is being used for fishing in the fishery waters.
(2) A person who contravenes an order under subsection (1), or the master
of a fishing craft who has on board a person he knows is banned from remaining
on the fishing craft by an order under subsection (1), is guilty of an offence.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units.

57 Removal of item in custody

A person who without lawful authority removes a fishing craft, vehicle,
aircraft or other item held in the custody of the Government of Niue under this
Act is guilty of an offence, whether or not the person knew the fishing craft, vehicle,
aircraft or other item was held in the custody of the Government of Niue.
Penalty: A fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units or imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 3 months, or both.
PART 10
GENERAL PENALTY AND LIABILITY

58 Liability of master

Where an offence against this Act has been committed by a person on board
or employed on a fishing vessel, the master of the vessel may be charged with the
same offence.

59 Penalties

If a penalty is not specified for an offence under this Act the penalty shall
be a fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty units.

60 Regulations

PART 11
REGULATIONS
(1) Cabinet may make all such regulations as may in the opinion of Cabinet be necessary or expedient for giving effect to this Act and for its due administration. (2) Without limiting the general power conferred by subsection (1),
regulations may be made under this section for all or any of the following –
(a) Providing for the conservation, management, development,
licensing and regulation of fisheries or any particular fishery;

Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1996

1585
(b) Licensing, authorisation or registration in respect of any fishing craft or class or category of fishing craft to be used for fishing, related activities or any other purpose under this Act, including the form, issuance requirements, grounds for denial, terms and conditions, and fees, charges, royalties and other form of compensation related to the licensing, authorisation or registration;
(c) Licensing, authorisation or registration in respect of any fisherman or class of fisherman, fishing gear and other equipment or device used for fishing;
(d) The operation of, and conditions and procedures to be observed by any fishing craft while in the fishery waters;
(e) The operation of, and conditions and procedures to be observed by
any other fishing craft which may enter the fishery waters for any
purpose under this Act;
(f) The catching, loading, landing, handling, transshipping,
transporting, possession and disposal of fish;
(g) The import, export, distribution and marketing of fish and fish
products;
(h) The manner in which any fishing gear is to be stowed;
(i) The appointment, powers and duties of authorised officers and
observers;
(j) The duties and procedures to be followed by the master and crew
of any vessel in respect of authorised officers and observers;
(k) Rewards to be paid to any person providing information on the
operations of foreign fishing craft leading to a conviction of an
offence against this Act;
(l) The licensing, control and use of fish aggregating devices and the
rights to the aggregated fish, and prescribing times and the
minimum distances from the device any vessel may fish around it;
(m) Regulating or prohibiting the use of self-contained underwater
breathing apparatus; and any other under-water breathing
apparatus other than a snorkel;
(n) Regulating or prohibiting the use of spear guns or other similar
devices;
(o) Registration of fishing craft and the standards and measures for
the safety of persons on board, and the safety of the fishing craft;
(p) Regulating aquaculture and access to land leased for aquaculture
and to the waters adjacent to the land;
(q) Prescribing the terms and conditions of leases for aquaculture;
(r) Requiring the provision of statistical and other information related
to fisheries;
(s) The control, inspection and conditions of operation for fish
processing establishments;
(t) The prevention of marine pollution, whether originating from a
land based source or by discharge at sea;
(u) The appointment, maintaining of and procedures for agents
appointed to receive and respond to process under this Act;
(v) The implementation of any access or related agreement or other
agreement or arrangement entered into under this Act;
(w) Regulating or prohibiting, either generally or in any specified
fishery –
1586 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(i) The taking of coral and shells;
(ii) The setting of fish fences or nets;
(iii) The taking of aquarium fish; or
(iv) Aquaculture operations;
(v) Prescribing measures for the protection of marine life;
(vi) Regulating or prohibiting fishing of all kinds within any lagoon
or any part of any lagoon, the time or times of year during
which that fishing may occur or is prohibited, and approving,
restricting, or prohibiting the equipment or methods which may
be used in connection with that fishing;
(x) Prescribing offences against the regulations and penalties for the
offences, not exceeding a fine of 2,500 penalty units and, where the
offence is a continuing one, a further fine not exceeding 5 penalty
units for each day that the offence continues;
(y) Regulating for –
(i) The implementation of an access agreement;
(ii) The implementation of any agreement to which the
Government of Niue is a party relating to the establishment of
uniform tests and conditions as between the parties to the
agreement in respect of conservation, management, exploitation
and surveillance, and
(iii) Access to and enforcement measures undertaken within the
fisheries waters of each party;
(z) Giving effect to the following International Conventions upon their
ratification by the Government of Niue and their entry into force
under international law or for Niue, as the case may be –
(i) The United Nations Conventions on the Law of the Sea 1982;
(ii) The Agreement for the Implementation of the Provisions of the
United Nations Convention on the Law of the Sea of 10
December 1982 Relating to the Conservation and Management
of Straddling Fish Stocks and Highly Migratory Fish Stocks,
1995 (the UN Fish Stocks Agreement;
(iii) The Convention on the Conservation and Management of
Highly Migratory Fish Stocks in the Western and Central Pacific
Ocean (the WCPT Convention);
(za) Prescribing the requirements for fishing in areas under national
jurisdiction of a foreign country or on the high seas or in areas subject
to international conservation and management measures in
accordance with international law binding on Niue by vessels
carrying the flag of Niue or nationals of Niue ordinarily resident in
Niue or foreign nationals ordinarily resident in Niue using vessels
carrying the flags of other states;
(zb) Implementing any decisions of international and regional fisheries
management bodies of which Niue is a member or with which Niue
has agreed to cooperate.

61-62 [Spent]

1587

TERRORISM SUPPRESSION AND TRANSNATIONAL CRIMES ACT 2006

2006/280 – 1 December 2006

PART 1 24 Appeal

PRELIMINARY

1 Short title Information

2

Principal objects

25

Disclosure of information

3

Interpretation

4 Definition of terrorist act PART 5

GENERAL POWERS

PART 2

26

Controlled delivery of property

SPECIFIED ENTITIES

27

Exchange of information relating to

5

United Nations listed entities to be specified

terrorist groups and terrorist acts

entities

PART 6

PART 3

COUNTER TERRORISM CONVENTION OFFENCES

OFFENCES

Nuclear Material

6

Financing of terrorism

28

Movement of nuclear material

7

Provision of property or services to

specified entity

29

Offences relating to nuclear material

8 Dealing with terrorist property Maritime Safety

9

Harbouring of persons committing terrorist

30

Definition of “ship”

acts

31

Offences

10

Provision of weapons to terrorist groups

32

Arrest and delivery

11

Recruitment of person to be members of

terrorist groups or to participate in terrorist Plastic Explosives

acts 33 Plastic explosives offences

PART 4

MANAGEMENT AND FORFEITURE OF PROPERTY OF

34

Terrorist Bombing

Terrorist bombing offences

SPECIFIED ENTITIES

Management Transnational Organised Crime

12

Order to take control of property

35

Participation in organised criminal group

13

Notice of order

14

Variation, revocation, or expiry of order

PART 7

15

Appeal

PEOPLE TRAFFICKING AND SMUGGLING

16

Third parties may apply for relief

People Trafficking

17

Court may grant relief to third party

36

Offence of trafficking in persons

37

Offence of trafficking in children

Forfeiture

38

Consent not a defence

18

Certain property excluded from forfeiture

39

Protection of trafficked persons

19

Application for forfeiture order

20 Making forfeiture order People Smuggling

21

Effect of forfeiture order

40

Offence of people smuggling

22

Protection of third parties

41

Offence to facilitate stay of an unauthorized

23

Return of property

person

1588 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 8

GENERAL PROVISIONS

48

Jurisdiction

49

Liability of body corporate

50

Obligation to extradite or prosecute

51

Restricted grounds for refusal to extradite

or provide mutual assistance

52

Consent of Attorney-General

53

Regulations

SCHEDULE

To provide for the suppression of terrorism and transnational crimes

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006.

2 Principal objects

The principal objects of this Act are to implement the United Nations
Security Council Resolution 1373 and Conventions dealing with terrorism and
transnational organised crime, to prevent terrorists from operating in Niue, and
to prevent persons in Niue from taking part in terrorist activities or supporting
terrorism.

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“Attorney-General” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Proceeds
of Crime Act 1998;
“authorised officer””means a constable, customs officer, or immigration
officer;
“Convention country” means a country that is party to a counter terrorism
convention;
“counter terrorism convention” means a Convention listed in the Schedule;
“craft” includes any aircraft, ship, boat, or other machine or vessel used or
capable of being used for the carriage or transportation of persons or
goods, or both, by air or water or over or under water;
“detection agent” means a substance in the table to Part 2 of the Technical
Annex to the Plastic Explosives Convention;
“entity” means a person, group, trust, partnership, fund, or an
unincorporated association or organisation;
“explosive or other lethal device” means –
(a) An explosive, weapon, or device that is designed or has the
capability to cause death, serious bodily injury, or substantial
material damage; or
(b) A weapon or device that is designed or has the capability to cause
death, serious bodily injury, or substantial material damage through
the release, dissemination, or impact of toxic chemicals, biological
agents, toxins, or similar substances or radiation or radioactive
materials;
“financial institution” has the same meaning as in section 3 of the Financial
Transactions Reporting Act 2006;

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006

1589
“Financial Intelligence Unit” means the Financial Intelligence Unit established under Part 5 of the Financial Transactions Reporting Act
2006;
“fixed platform” means an artificial island, installation or structure
permanently attached to the seabed for the purposes of exploration or
exploitation of resources or for other economic purposes;
“forfeiture order” means an order made under section 21;
“international nuclear transport” means the carriage of a consignment of
nuclear material by any means of transportation intended to go beyond
the territory of the country where the shipment originates –
(a) Beginning with the departure from a facility of the shipper in the
country; and
(b) Ending with the arrival at a facility of the receiver within the country
of ultimate destination;
“international organisation” means any organisation of States or
Governments of States or any organ or any agency of any organisation
of that kind;
“military device” includes a shell, bomb, projectile, mine, missile, rocket,
charge, grenade, or perforator, lawfully manufactured exclusively for
military or police purposes;
“Niuean land” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Niue Amendment
Act (No. 2) 1968;
“nuclear material” means any of the following –
(a) plutonium with an isotopic concentration of not more than 80% in
plutonium-238;
(b) uranium-233;
(c) uranium containing uranium-233, or uranium-235, or both;
(d) uranium with a naturally occurring isotopic concentration, other
than uranium in the form of an ore or ore residue;
(e) a substance containing nuclear material;
“Nuclear Material Convention” means the Convention for the Physical
Protection of Nuclear Material, done at Vienna and New York on 3
March 1980;
“organised criminal group” means a group of at least 3 persons, existing
for a period of time, that acts together with an objective of obtaining
material benefits from the commission of offences that are punishable
by a maximum penalty of at least 4 years imprisonment;
“plastic explosive” means an explosive that is –
(a) formulated with one or more high explosives that, in their pure
form, have a vapour pressure less than 10-4 Pa at a temperature of
25°C; and
(b) formulated with a binder material; and
(c) when mixed, malleable or flexible at normal room temperature;
“Plastic Explosives Convention” means the Convention on the Marking of
Plastic Explosives for the Purposes of Identification, done at Montreal
on 1 March 1991;
“privileged communication” means a confidential communication, whether
made directly or indirectly through an agent between –
(a) A lawyer in his or her professional capacity and another lawyer in
the same capacity; or
(b) A lawyer in his or her professional capacity and his or her client;
and
1590 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
to obtain or give legal advice or assistance; but
not for the purpose of committing or assisting the commission of an
illegal or wrongful act;
“property” includes –
(a) assets of every kind, whether corporeal or incorporeal, moveable
or immoveable, tangible or intangible; and
(b) legal documents or instruments in any form, including electronic
or digital, evidencing title to, or interest in, those assets including,
but not limited to, bank credits, traveller ’s cheques, bank cheques,
money orders, shares, securities, bonds, drafts, and letters of credit;
“Rome Convention” means the Convention for the Suppression of Unlawful
Acts against the Safety of Maritime Navigation, adopted at Rome on
10 March, 1988;
“specified entity” means a person or entity that is prescribed under section
5;
“trafficking in persons” means the recruitment, transportation, transfer,
harbouring, or receipt of a person by improper means such as force,
abduction, fraud or coercion for an improper purpose such as forced
or coerced labour, servitude, slavery or sexual exploitation;
“terrorist act” has the meaning given by section 4;
“terrorist group” means –
(a) An entity that has as one of its activities or purposes committing or
facilitating the commission of a terrorist act; or
(b) A group that is a specified entity;
“terrorist property” means –
(a) Property that has been, is being, or is likely to be, used to commit a
terrorist act; or
(b) Property that has been, is being, or is likely to be, used by a terrorist
group; or
(c) Property owned or controlled, or derived or generated from
property owned or controlled, by or on behalf of a specified entity;
“unmarked plastic explosive” means a plastic explosive that –
(a) Does not contain a detection agent; or
(b) At the time of manufacture, does not contain the minimum
concentration level of a detection agent set out in the table to Part 2
of the Technical Annex to the Plastic Explosives Convention; and
“weapon” includes a firearm, chemical, biological, or nuclear weapon.

4

that –

Definition of terrorist act

(1) For the purposes of this Act “terrorist act” means an act or omission
(a) Constitutes an offence within the scope of a counter terrorism convention; or
(b) Is mentioned in subsection (2).
(2) For paragraph (1)(b), the act or omission must –
(a) Involve death or serious bodily injury to a person (other than the
person carrying out the act); or
(b) Involve serious damage to property; or
(c) Endanger a person’s life; or
(d) Create a serious risk to the health or safety of the public or a section
of the public; or

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006 1591

(e) Involve the use of weapons; or
(f) Involve introducing into the environment, distributing, or exposing
the public to any –
(i) dangerous, hazardous, radioactive, or harmful substance; or
(ii) toxic chemical; or
(iii) microbial or other biological agent; or
(g) Involve serious disruption to any system or the provision of services
directly related to essential infrastructure; and
(i) must be intended or, by its nature and context, reasonably be
regarded as being intended –
(A) to intimidate the public or a section of the public; or
(B) to compel a Government or an international organisation
to do, or refrain from doing, any act; and
(ii) must be made for the purpose of advancing a political,
ideological, or religious cause.
(3) However, an act or omission mentioned in subsection (2) does not include
an act or omission that –
(a) Is committed as part of an advocacy, protest, demonstration, dissent,
or industrial action, and is not intended to result in any harm
mentioned in subparagraph (2)(a)(i), (ii), (iii), or (iv); or
(b) Occurs in a situation of armed conflict and is, at the time and in the
place it occurred, in accordance with rules of international law
applicable to the conflict.
PART 2
SPECIFIED ENTITIES

5 United Nations listed entities to be specified entities

(1) For the purposes of this Act, the entities listed from time to time by the
United Nations Security Council as terrorist entities are “specified entities”.
(2) The Minister must, by notice published in the Gazette, give notice of
the list of terrorist entities referred to in subsection (1), and continue to give notice
as and when the United Nations Security Council adds or removes any terrorist
entity from that list.
(3) A list of United Nations terrorist entities prepared and certified by the
Minister is deemed to be prima facie evidence that the list is a correct list of entities
listed by the United Nations Security Council as terrorist entities.

6 Financing of terrorism

PART 3
OFFENCES
(1) A person who provides or collects, by any means, directly or indirectly, any property, intending, knowing, or having reasonable grounds to believe that the property will be used, in full or in part, to carry out a terrorist act, commits and offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding
14 years.
(2) A person commits an offence who provides or collects, by any means,
directly or indirectly, any property intending, knowing, or having reasonable
grounds to believe that they will benefit an entity that the person knows is a
specified entity.
(3) In a prosecution for an offence against subsection (1) or subsection (2),
it is not necessary for the prosecutor to prove that the property collected or provided
were actually used, in full or in part, to carry out a terrorist act.
1592 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

7 Provision of property or services to specified entity

(1) A person who, directly or indirectly, knowingly makes available
property, financial, or other related services to, or for the benefit of, a specified
entity commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term
not exceeding 14 years.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the provision of the property or service
is of a kind that is authorised by a resolution of the United Nations Security Council.

8 Dealing with terrorist property

(1) A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 14 years, who knowingly –
(a) Deals, directly or indirectly, in any terrorist property; or
(b) Collects or acquires or possesses terrorist property; or
(c) Enters into, or facilitates, directly or indirectly, any transaction in
respect of terrorist property; or
(d) Converts, conceals, or disguises terrorist property.
(2) A person does not commit an offence under paragraph (1)(a), (b), or (c)
if the person –
(a) Tells the Attorney-General, in writing, as soon as the person becomes
aware that the property is terrorist property; and
(b) Acts in accordance with any direction of the Attorney-General for
the property.

9 Harbouring of persons committing terrorist acts

A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 7 years, who harbours or conceals, or prevents, hinders,
or interferes with the apprehension of any other person knowing or having reason
to believe that the other person –
(a) Has committed, or is planning, or is likely to commit, a terrorist
act; or
(b) Is a member of a specified entity.

10 Provision of weapons to terrorist groups

A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 7 years, who knowingly offers to provide, or provides, a
weapon to –
(a) A specified entity; or
(b) A member of a specified entity; or
(c) Any other person for use by, or for the benefit of, a specified entity
or a member of a specified entity.

11 Recruitment of person to be members of terrorist groups or to participate in terrorist acts

A person commits an offence is liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 7 years, who knowingly agrees to recruit, or recruits, another person –
(a) To be a member of a terrorist group; or
(b) To participate in the commission of a terrorist act.

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006 1593

PART 4
MANAGEMENT AND FORFEITURE OF PROPERTY OF SPECIFIED ENTITIES

Management

12 Order to take control of property

(1) The Attorney-General may apply to the Court for an order under
subsection (3) for property in Niue if the Attorney-General has reasonable grounds
to believe that the property is terrorist property.
(2) The Court –
(a) May make orders for service of the application; and
(b) May deal with the application ex parte.
(3) If the Court is satisfied that there is evidence to support the application,
the Court may direct the Registrar of the High Court to take custody and control
of the property.
(4) The order –
(a) Must specify the property concerned; and
(b) May be subject to conditions.
(5) A person who has custody and control of the property specified in the
order must allow the Registrar of the High Court to take custody and control of
the property in accordance with the order.

13 Notice of order

(1) Notice of the making of an order under section 12 must be given –
(a) If practicable, as soon as possible to the person who owns or controls
the property if the person or a representative of the person is in
Niue; and
(b) To any other person that the Attorney-General thinks may have an
interest in the property.
(2) Failure to comply with subsection (1) does not affect the validity of the
order.

14 Variation, revocation, or expiry of order

(1) If the Court has made an order under section 12, the Court may, on
application by the Attorney-General or by the person who owns or controls the
property –
(a) Make another order under section 12 varying the conditions of the order or the property that is subject to the order; or
(b) Revoke the order.
(2) If the application is made by the person who owns or controls the
property –
(a) The person must give 14 days notice in writing of the application to the Attorney-General; and
(b) Before deciding on the application, the Court must hear from the
Attorney-General.
(3) The Court must –
(a) If the Court decides that there are reasonable grounds to do so,
revoke the order; or
(b) If the Court decides that there are no reasonable grounds to revoke
the order, refuse the application.
(4) If the Court revokes the order, the Attorney-General must:
(a) Tell the person who owns or controls the property in writing; and
(b) Publish a notice of revocation in the Gazette.
1594 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(5) If not earlier revoked, an order under section 12 about property of a specified entity expires if –
(a) For property of a specified entity, the entity ceases to be a specified entity; or
(b) A forfeiture order is made under section 21 in relation to the property

15 Appeal

The Attorney-General or a person whose property is subject to an order
may, within 21 days of the making of the order, appeal to the Court of Appeal
against a decision made by the Court under this Part.

16 Third parties may apply for relief

(1) A person, other than the person who owns or controls the property,
who claims an interest in the property that is subject to an order under section 12
may apply to the Court for an order under section 17.
(2) The person must give 14 days notice in writing of the application to the
Attorney-General, who is a party to any proceedings on the application.

17 Court may grant relief to third party

(1) Subsection (2) applies if –
(a) A person makes an application under section 16; and
(b) The Court is satisfied that the person’s claim to the interest is valid.
(2) The Court must make an order –
(a) Declaring the nature, extent, and value of the person’s interest in
the property; and
(b) Declaring that the interest is no longer subject to the order under
section 12; and
(c) If the interest is held by the Registrar of the High Court –
(i) directing the Registrar of the High Court to transfer the interest
to the person; or
(ii) declaring that there is payable, by the Registrar of the High
Court to the person, an amount equal to the value of the interest
declared by the Court.
(3) The Court may refuse to make an order if it is satisfied that –
(a) The person was knowingly involved in any way in the carrying
out of the terrorist acts that are the basis of the designation of the
entity as a specified entity, or is an entity that is wholly owned or
effectively controlled, directly or indirectly, by the specified entity;
or
(b) If the person acquired the interest at the time of, or after the
designation of, the entity as a specified entity, the applicant did not
acquire the interest in the property in good faith and for value,
without knowing or having reason to believe that the property was,
at the time of the acquisition, property subject to an order under
section 12.

Forfeiture

18 Certain property excluded from forfeiture

A forfeiture order must not be made against property that is Niuean land
or that is a leasehold right under section 29 of the Land Act 1969.

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006

1595

19 Application for forfeiture order

(1) The Attorney-General may apply to the Court for a forfeiture order
against terrorist property.
(2) The Attorney-General must –
(a) Name as respondents to the application only those persons who
are known to own or control the property that is the subject of the
application; and
(b) Give notice of the application to each respondent in the manner
directed by the Court.
(3) The Court may, at any time before the final determination of the
application, make orders for –
(a) Service of the application on any person whom the Court thinks
has an interest in the property; and
(b) Publication of notice of the application in the Gazette.
(4) Any person who claims an interest in the property may appear and
present evidence at the hearing of the application.

20 Making forfeiture order

(1) If the Court is satisfied, on the balance of probabilities, that the property
that is the subject of the application is terrorist property, the Court must order that
the property be forfeited to the Government of Niue.
(2) If the Court is satisfied that a person mentioned in section 20(2)(a) or
(3)(a) –
(a) Has an interest in the property that is the subject of the application;
and
(b) Has exercised reasonable care to ensure that the property is not
terrorist property; and
(c) Is not a member of a specified entity;
the Court must order that the interest is not affected by the order and declare the
nature and extent of the interest.
(3) If the Court makes a forfeiture order, the Court may give any directions
that are necessary or convenient to give effect to the order.
(4) If the Court refuses to make a forfeiture order, the Court must make an
order that describes the property and that declares that it is not terrorist property.

21 Effect of forfeiture order

(1) If the Court makes a forfeiture order against property (other than
registrable property), the order vests the property absolutely in the Government
of Niue.
(2) If the Court makes an order against registrable property –
(a) The order vests the property in the Government of Niue in equity,
but does not vest it in the Government of Niue at law until the
applicable registration requirements have been complied with; and
(b) The Government of Niue is entitled to be registered as owner of the
property; and
(c) The Attorney-General may do, or authorise the doing of, anything
necessary or convenient to obtain the registration of the Government
of Niue as owner, including the executing of any necessary
instrument; and
(d) the Attorney-General may do anything necessary or convenient to
give notice of, or otherwise protect, the Government of Niue’s
equitable interest in the property; and
1596 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(e) Anything done by the Attorney-General under paragraph (d) is not a dealing for the purposes of paragraph (3)(a).
(3) If the Court makes a forfeiture order against property (including registrable property) –
(a) The property must not, except with leave of the Court and in accordance with any directions of the Court, be disposed of, or otherwise dealt with, by or for the Government of Niue, until 6 months after the forfeiture order was made; and
(b) The property may be disposed of, and the proceeds applied or
otherwise dealt with as the Attorney-General directs, until 6 months
after the forfeiture order was made

22 Protection of third parties

(1) A person who claims an interest in property that has been forfeited
and who has not been given notice under section 19(2)(b) or (3)(a) may apply to
the Court within 6 months after the forfeiture order was made for an order under
subsection (4).
(2) The person must give 14 days notice in writing of the application to the
Attorney-General.
(3) The Attorney-General –
(a) Is a party to the proceedings in an application under subsection (1);
and
(b) May make an application under subsection (1) for a person.
(4) If a person applies to the Court for an order about the person’s interest
in property, the Court must make an order declaring the nature, extent, and value
(as at the time the order is made) of the person’s interest if the Court is satisfied in
accordance with section 20(2).
(5) An appeal lies to the Court of Appeal from an order under subsection
(4).

23 Return of property

(1) The Attorney-General must on application by a person who has
obtained an order under section 22(4), if the period for appeals has expired and
any appeal from that order has been determined or has lapsed –
(a) Arrange for the return of the property, or the part of it to which the
interest of the applicant relates, to the applicant; or
(b) If the interest in the property is no longer vested in the Government
of Niue, pay an amount equal to the value of the interest of the
applicant, as declared in the order, to the applicant.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply to any property returned, or amount paid,
to the person under section 17.

24 Appeal

The Attorney-General or a person affected by a decision made by the Court
under this Part may appeal to the Court of Appeal against the decision.

25 Disclosure of information

Information

(1) A financial institution must immediately tell the Attorney-General about the existence of any property in its possession or control:
(a) That is owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by or for a specified entity, including property derived or generated from that property; or

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006

1597
(b) For which there are reasonable grounds to suspect is property of a kind specified in paragraph (a).
(2) The Attorney-General may tell the Financial Intelligence Unit or other appropriate authority of a foreign country about any information it has about any property of the kind mentioned in subsection (1), if the Attorney-General thinks the information would be relevant to the foreign country.
(3) Information may be given under subsection (2) subject to any conditions that the Attorney-General determines.
(4) A financial institution must tell the Financial Intelligence Unit about
every dealing that occurs in the course of its activities and for which there are
reasonable grounds to suspect is related to the commission of a terrorist act.
(5) No civil or criminal proceedings lie against a person for making a
disclosure or report in good faith under subsections (1), (2), or (4).
(6) Nothing in subsection (1) or (4) requires a lawyer to disclose a privileged
communication.
(7) A person who receives information under subsection (1), (2), or (4) must
not disclose the information or its source except –
(a) For the purposes of –
(i) the enforcement of this Act; or
(ii) the detection, investigation, or prosecution of an offence under
this Act; or
(iii) providing assistance under the Mutual Assistance in Criminal
Matters Act 1998; or
(b) In accordance with an order of a Court.
(8) A person who contravenes subsections (1) or (4) commits an offence
and is liable on conviction on indictment to a term of imprisonment not exceeding
7 years.
PART 5
GENERAL POWERS

26 Controlled delivery of property

(1) This section applies to an authorised officer who has reasonable grounds
to believe that a person has committed, is committing, or is about to commit, an offence under this Act.
(2) The authorised officer may allow property, which the authorised officer
reasonably suspects has been, is being, or may be used to commit an offence under
this Act, to enter, leave, or move through Niue for the purpose of gathering evidence
to identify a person or to facilitate a prosecution for the offence.
(3) An authorised officer does not commit an offence under this Act if:
(a) The authorised officer is engaged in the investigation of a suspected
offence under this Act; and
(b) The offence involves property that the authorised officer reasonably
suspects has been, is being, or may be used, to commit an offence
under this Act; and
(c) The authorised officer does not take action that the authorised officer
would otherwise be required to take under this Act for the purpose
of the investigation.
1598 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

27 Exchange of information relating to terrorist groups and terrorist acts

The Attorney-General may disclose to the appropriate authority of a foreign
country any information in his or her possession relating to any of the following –
(a) The actions or movements of terrorist groups or persons suspected
of involvement in the commission of terrorist acts; and
(b) The use of forged or falsified travel papers by persons suspected of
involvement in the commission of terrorist acts; and
(c) Traffic in explosives or other lethal devices by terrorist groups or
persons suspected of involvement in the commission of terrorist
acts; and
(d) The use of communication technologies by terrorist groups; and
if the disclosure is not prohibited by any provision of law and will not, in the
Attorney-General’s view, prejudice national security or public safety.
PART 6
COUNTER TERRORISM CONVENTION OFFENCES

Nuclear Material

28 Movement of nuclear material

(1) A person commits an offence who knowingly imports or exports nuclear
material to or from Niue, except with the written permission of Cabinet.
(2) A person commits an offence who knowingly, without written
permission from the Cabinet, transports nuclear material –
(a) Over the territory of Niue; or
(b) Through any of its seaports or airports.
(3) The written permission specified in subsections (1) and (2) may be given
only if the Cabinet has received a written assurance from the person that the
material will, during international nuclear transport, be protected at the levels set
out in the Nuclear Material Convention.
(4) A person who commits an offence against subsections (1) or (2) or who
knowingly makes a false statement or provides a false assurance to the Cabinet
under subsections (1) or (2) is liable on conviction to a term of imprisonment not
exceeding 10 years.

29 Offences relating to nuclear material

A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 14 years, who intentionally –
(a) Without lawful authority receives, possesses, uses, transfers, alters,
disposes of, or disperses nuclear material in a way that causes, or is
likely to cause, death or serious injury to a person or substantial
damage to property; or
(b) Steals nuclear material; or
(c) Embezzles or fraudulently obtains nuclear material; or
(d) Demands nuclear material by threat, or use of force, or any other
form of intimidation; or
(e) Threatens –
(i) to use nuclear material to cause death or serious injury to any
person or substantial damage to property; or
(ii) to steal nuclear material to compel a person, State, or an
international organisation to do or refrain from doing any act.

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006 1599

30 Definition of “ship”

Maritime Safety

For the purposes of sections 31 and 32 –
(a) “Ship” means a vessel that is not permanently attached to the seabed
including a hovercraft, hydrofoil, submarine or other floating craft,
but does not include a warship, a ship owned or operated by a
State and being used as a naval auxiliary or for customs or police
purposes, or a ship that has been withdrawn from navigation; and
(b) A duty of a master of a ship to arrest, detain, and notify the
appropriate authority in Niue includes any other country that is a
party to the Rome Convention.

31 Offences

(1) A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 20 years, who unlawfully and intentionally –
(a) Seizes, or exercises control over, a ship or fixed platform by force,
or by threat of force, or by other form of intimidation; or
(b) Commits an act of violence against a person on board a ship or
fixed platform that is likely to endanger the safe navigation of the
ship or safety of the fixed platform; or
(c) Destroys a ship or fixed platform; or
(d) Causes damage to a ship or its cargo or a fixed platform that is
likely to endanger the safe navigation of the ship or safety of the
fixed platform; or
(e) Places, or causes to be placed, on a ship or fixed platform, a device
or substance likely –
(i) for a ship, to destroy the ship or cause damage to the ship or its
cargo that is likely to endanger the safe navigation of the ship;
or
(ii) for a fixed platform, to destroy the fixed platform or to endanger
its safety; or
(f) Destroys or seriously damages maritime navigational facilities or
seriously interferes with their operation in a way that is likely to
endanger the safe navigation of a ship; or
(g) Communicates information that he or she knows to be false and
that endangers the safe navigation of a ship; or
(h) Injures or kills a person in connection with the commission, or
attempted commission, of an offence set out in paragraphs (a), (b),
(c), (d), (e), (f), or (g).
(2) A person commits an offence and is liable to conviction on indictment
to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 14 years who, with the intention of
compelling another person to do or to refrain from doing any act, threatens to
commit an offence mentioned in subsection (1)(b), (c), (d), or (f) in relation to a
ship or fixed platform, if the threat is likely to endanger the safety of the ship or
fixed platform.

32 Arrest and delivery

(1) The master of a ship registered in Niue who has reasonable grounds to
believe that a person has committed an offence under section 31 against, or on
board, any ship may –
(a) Arrest and detain the person; and
(b) Deliver the person to the appropriate authorities in any other
Convention country.
1600 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) The master of the ship must –
(a) Notify the authorities in the other Convention country before
delivering the person; and
(b) Give to the authorities evidence in his or her possession that the
person has committed the offence.
(3) If the person is delivered to a constable –
(a) The constable must take the person into custody unless he or she
has reasonable grounds to believe that the person has not committed
the offence; and
(b) If the constable refuses to take the person into custody, give reasons
for the refusal.
(4) A master of a ship who contravenes subsection (2), commits an offence
and is liable on conviction to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 7 years.

Plastic Explosives

33 Plastic explosives offences

(1) A person commits an offence who manufactures plastic explosives
knowing that they are unmarked.
(2) A person commits an offence who possesses or transports unmarked
plastic explosives knowing that they are unmarked.
(3) A person commits an offence who imports or exports unmarked plastic
explosives.
(4) It is not an offence under subsections (1) or (2) if –
(a) The person manufactures or holds unmarked explosives in a
quantity approved, in writing by Cabinet, solely for the use –
(i) in research, development, or testing of new or modified
explosives; or
(ii) in training in explosives detection or in the development or
testing of explosives detection equipment; or
(iii) for forensic science purposes; or
(b) The unmarked plastic explosives are destined to be, and are
incorporated as, an integral part of duly authorised military devices
in Niue within 3 years after the coming into force of the Plastic
Explosives Convention in Niue.
(5) It is not an offence under subsection (2) if the person possesses or
transports unmarked plastic explosives in a quantity, approved in writing by
Cabinet, solely for the use mentioned in subsection (4).
(6) A person who commits an offence under this section is liable on
conviction to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 7 years.

Terrorist Bombing

34 Terrorist bombing offences

(1) Subsection (2) applies to an action that is intended by a person –
(a) To cause death or serious bodily injury; or
(b) To cause extensive damage to a place mentioned in subsection (2)(a)
or (b), a facility mentioned in subsection (2)(c), or a facility
mentioned in subsection (2)(d), if the damage results in, or is likely
to result in, major economic loss.
(2) A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a term of
imprisonment not exceeding 14 years, who unlawfully and intentionally delivers,
places, discharges, or detonates an explosive or other lethal device in, into, or
against –

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006 1601

(a) A part of a building, land, street, waterway or other location that is accessible or open to members of the public, whether continuously or occasionally, including a commercial, business, cultural, historical, educational, religious, governmental, entertainment, recreational, or similar place; or
(b) A facility or conveyance that is used or occupied, in connection
with his or her official duties, by –
(i) a representative of any Government; or
(ii) the Head of State of any country; or
(iii) the Prime Minister or a Minister of any country; or
(iv) a member of the legislature of any country; or
(v) a Judge of any country; or
(vi) a public official or employee of a Government or public
authority or an inter-governmental organisation; or
(c) A facility, conveyance, or instrumentality, whether public or
privately owned, that is used in or for a publicly available service
for the transportation of persons or cargo; or
(d) A publicly or privately owned facility providing or distributing
services for the benefit of the public, such as water, energy, fuel, or
communications.

Transnational Organised Crime

35 Participation in organised criminal group

A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to imprisonment
for a term not exceeding 7 years, who participates (whether as a member, associate
member, or prospective member) in an organised criminal group, knowing that it
is an organised criminal group; and –
(a) Knowing that his or her participation contributes to the occurrence
of criminal activity; or
(b) Reckless as to whether his or her participation contributes to the
occurrence of criminal activity.
PART 7
PEOPLE TRAFFICKING AND SMUGGLING

People Trafficking

36 Offence of trafficking in persons

A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a term of
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 14 years, who engages in trafficking in
persons or is involved in the arranging of trafficking of persons knowing that the
person’s entry into Niue or any other country is or was arranged by means not in
accordance with the law of Niue or that other country.

37 Offence of trafficking in children

A person commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a term of
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 20 years, who intentionally engages in
trafficking in a person who is a child or is involved in the arranging of trafficking
in a person who is a child, regardless of whether the child’s entry into Niue or any
other country is or was arranged by means not in accordance with the law of Niue
or that other country.
1602 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

38 Consent not a defence

It shall not be a defence to any prosecution under section 36 or section 37 –
(a) That the trafficked person consented to the intended exploitation;
or
(b) That the intended exploitation did not occur.

39 Protection for trafficked persons

(1) A trafficked person is not liable to prosecution for ­
(a) The act of trafficking in persons or being a party to an offence of
trafficking in persons; or
(b) The trafficked person’s illegal entry into Niue in connection with
the act of trafficking in persons if Niue is the receiving country; or
(c) The trafficked person’s period of unlawful residence in Niue after
being trafficked, if Niue is the receiving country; or
(d) The trafficked person’s procurement or possession of any fraudulent
travel or identity documents that the person obtained, or with which
the trafficked person was supplied, for the purpose of entering the
receiving country in connection with the act of trafficking in persons.
(2) Subsection (1) shall not prevent the removal from Niue of a trafficked
person in accordance with Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985.

People Smuggling

40 Offence of people smuggling

(1) A person who, in order to obtain a material benefit, engages in people
smuggling either knowing or being reckless as to the fact that the entry of the
person being or to be, smuggled into the country is illegal commits an offence and
is liable on conviction to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 14 years.
(2) Subsection (1) applies whether or not the person being smuggled enters
or arrives in the receiving country.

41 Offence to facilitate stay of an unauthorised person

A person who knowingly facilitates the continued presence of an
unauthorised person in a receiving country in order to obtain a material benefit
commits an offence and is liable on conviction to a term of imprisonment not
exceeding 14 years.

42 Aggravated offences

(1) A person commits an aggravated offence of any of the offences
mentioned in sections 40 or 41 who commits that offence in 1 or more of the
following circumstances –
(a) The unauthorised person is subjected to torture or to any other cruel,
inhuman or degrading treatment (including exploitation);
(b) The life or safety of the person being smuggled is, or is likely to be,
endangered.
(2) A person who commits an offence against subsection (1) is liable on
conviction to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 20 years.

43 Protection for smuggled persons

(1) An unauthorised person is not liable to prosecution for an offence
against sections 40 and 41, by reason only of the fact that the person is the object of
the following conduct –

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006 1603

(a) People smuggling;
(b) When committed for the purpose of enabling people smuggling,
an offence against section 46;
(c) An offence against section 41.
(2) For the avoidance of doubt, nothing in subsection (1) prevents
proceedings being taken against an unauthorised person for an act or omission
that constitutes an offence under any other law.

44 Boarding, search and detention of craft

(1) This section applies to a craft that is a ship, boat or other machine or
vessel used or capable of being used for the carriage of persons by water or over
water, except for a foreign warship.
(2) An authorised officer may stop and board the craft within Niue if the
authorised officer has reasonable grounds to believe the craft –
(a) Is being used to commit an offence against section 40; and
(b) The craft is in –
(i) Niue; or
(ii) the contiguous zone of Niue.
(3) The authorised officer may, when reasonably necessary for the exercise
of his or her functions in connection with an offence against section 40 –
(a) Direct the craft to stay where it is, or direct it to be taken to a suitable
place in Niue, for the purpose of search; and
(b) Search and detain the craft, anyone on it and anything on it; and
(c) Question any person on board the craft; and
(d) Require the production of any documents relating to the craft or
any travel or identity documents of a person on the craft; and
(e) Take a copy of any documents produced; and
(f) Seize and detain anything found on the craft that appears to him or
her to be evidence of an offence against this Part; and
(g) Remain on the craft for such period as is reasonably necessary for
the purpose of boarding, searching and directing the craft or
carrying out an investigation for an offence against section 40.
(4) If the craft fails to stop at the request of the authorised officer, the officer
may pursue it into international waters and take any action that is reasonable
necessary to stop the craft and enable it to be boarded (other than in the territorial
sea of another country).
(5) The authorised officer may require the person in charge of the craft, a
member of the crew or any person on board to take any action that may be directed
by the officer for paragraph (3)(a).
(6) The person in charge of the craft must give any authorised officer who
remains on board the craft proper and sufficient food and suitable accommodation
without charge.
(7) Any person who fails to comply with a direction of an authorised officer
under this section commits an offence and is liable on conviction on indictment to
a fine not exceeding 500 penalty units or a term of imprisonment not exceeding 5
years, or both.

Exploitation

45 Exploitation of people not legally entitled to work

(1) An employer commits an offence who allows an unlawful employee to
undertake employment in the employer ’s service and takes any action with the
intention of preventing or hindering the employee from –
1604 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) Leaving Niue; or
(b) Ascertaining or seeking that person’s entitlement under the law of
Niue; or
(c) Disclosing to any person the circumstances of that person’s
employment by the employer.
(2) Without limiting the generality of subsection (1), the following are
examples of actions of the kind mentioned in that subsection –
(a) Taking or retaining possession or control of a person’s passport,
any other travel or identity document, or travel tickets;
(b) Preventing or hindering a person from –
(i) having access to a telephone; or
(ii) using a telephone; or
(ii) using a telephone privately; or
(iv) leaving premises; or
(v) leaving premises unaccompanied;
(c) Preventing or hindering a authorised officer from entering or having
access to any place or premises to which the person is entitled to
have access under any law.
(3) An employer who commits an offence under this section is liable to a
fine not exceeding 500 penalty units or to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 5
years, or both.

General

46 Offence relating to fraudulent travel or identity documents

A person commits an offence, and is liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 500 penalty units or to a term of imprisonment not exceeding 5 years or
both, who knowingly and in order to obtain a material benefit –
(a) Produces a fraudulent travel or identity document; or
(b) Procures, provides or possesses a fraudulent travel or identity
document.

47 Obligation on commercial carriers

(1) A commercial carrier commits an offence and is liable on conviction to
a fine not exceeding 500 penalty units, who transports a person into Niue if, on
entry into the Niue, the person does not have the travel documents required for
lawful entry.
(2) A commercial carrier is not guilty of an offence under subsection (1)
if –
(a) The commercial carrier had reasonable grounds to believe that the documents that the person has are the travel documents required for lawful entry of that person into Niue; or
(b) The person possessed the travel documents required for lawful entry into Niue when that person boarded, or last boarded, the means of transport to travel to Niue; or
(c) Entry into Niue occurred only because of illness of or injury to a person on board, emergency, stress of weather or other circumstances beyond the control of the commercial carrier.
(3) A commercial carrier that commits an offence under this section is liable
to pay the costs of the person’s detention in, and removal from Niue.

Terrorism Suppression and Transnational Crimes Act 2006

1605

48 Jurisdiction

PART 8
GENERAL PROVISIONS
Proceedings may be brought for an offence under this Act – (a) If the act or omission –
(i) is committed in Niue; or
(ii) is committed on board a ship or aircraft registered in Niue; or
(iii) is committed outside Niue by a person who is now in Niue; or
(b) Whether or not the act or omission constituting the offence is
committed in or outside Niue, if the act or omission –
(i) is committed by a Niuean or permanent resident of Niue or a
citizen of any country who is ordinarily resident in Niue; or
(ii) is committed in order to compel the Government of Niue to
do, or to abstain from doing, any act; or
(iii) is committed against a Niuean or a permanent resident of Niue;
or
(iv) is committed by a person who is, after the commission of the
offence, present in Niue; or
(v) is intended to be committed in Niue; or
(vi) originates in, or transits, Niue.

49 Liability of body corporate

(1) This Act applies to a body corporate in the same way as it applies to an
individual; and a body corporate may be found guilty of any of the offences set
out in this Act, in addition to the liability of any person for the same offence.
(2) For an offence under this Act, the conduct or state of mind of an
employee, agent, or officer of a body corporate is taken to be attributed to the
body corporate if that person is acting –
(a) Within the scope of the person’s employment; or
(b) Within the scope of the person’s actual or apparent authority; or
(c) With the consent or agreement (express or implied) of a director,
servant, or agent of a body corporate, and giving that consent is
within the actual or apparent authority of the director, servant, or
agent.
(3) A reference in this section to the “state of mind of a person” includes
the person’s knowledge, intention, opinion, belief, or purpose, and the person’s
reasons for that intentions, opinion, belief, or purpose.

50 Obligation to extradite or prosecute

(1) If the Attorney-General refuses a request from another country to
extradite a person under the Extradition Act 1965, and the extradition request
relates to an act or omission that may constitute an offence listed in subsection (2),
the Attorney-General must submit the matter to the police.
(2) The offences referred to in subsection (1) are those set out in sections 6
to 11, 28, 29, 31, 33, 34, and 35.

51 Restricted grounds for refusal to extradite or provide mutual assistance (1) Notwithstanding the Extradition Act 1965 or the Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998, an offence under this Act or any other Act, where the act or omission constituting the offence also constitutes a terrorist act, is taken, for

the purposes of extradition and mutual assistance, not to be –
1606 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) An offence of a political character or an offence connected with a political offence or an offence inspired by a political motive; or
(b) A fiscal offence.
(2) Notwithstanding the Mutual Assistance in Criminal Matters Act 1998,
no request for mutual assistance in relation to an offence under this Act may be
declined solely on the basis of bank secrecy.

52 Consent of Attorney-General

(1) Proceedings for any offence under this Act for which jurisdiction is
claimed under section 36(1)(a)(ii) for an offence committed on board a ship
elsewhere than in Niue or for any other offence committed outside Niue may
only be instituted with the consent of the Attorney-General.
(2) Subsection (1) does not prevent the arrest, or the issue of a warrant for
the arrest, of any person for any offence, or the remanding in custody or on bail of
any person charged with any offence.

53 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as are necessary or convenient for the
purposes of this Act.
–––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

Section 4(1)

COUNTER TERRORISM CONVENTIONS

1 Convention on Offences and certain Other Acts committed on Board Aircraft,

done at Tokyo on 14 September 1963.

2 Convention for the Suppression of Unlawful Seizure of Aircraft, done at The Hague

on 16 December 1970.

3 Convention for the Suppression of Unlawful Acts Against the Safety of Civil

Aviation, done at Montreal on 23 September 1971.

4 Convention on the Prevention and Punishment of Crimes Against Internationally

Protected Persons, including Diplomatic Agents, adopted by the General Assembly of

the United Nations on 14 December 1973.

5 International Convention against the taking of Hostages, adopted by the General

Assembly of the United Nations on 17 December 1979.

6 Convention on the Physical Protection of Nuclear Material, done at Vienna and

New York on 3 March 1980.

7 Protocol for the Suppression of Unlawful Acts of Violence at Airports Serving

International Civil Aviation, supplementary to the Convention for the Suppression of

Unlawful Acts Against the Safety of Civil Aviation, done at Montreal on 24 February

1988.

8 Convention for the Suppression of Unlawful Acts Against the Safety of Maritime

Navigation, done at Rome on 10 March 1988.

9 Protocol for the Suppression of Unlawful Acts Against the Safety of Fixed Platforms

located on the Continental Shelf, done at Rome on 10 March 1988.

10 Convention on the Marking of Plastic Explosives for the Purposes of Detection,

done at Montreal on 1 March 1991.

11 International Convention for the Suppression of Terrorist Bombings, adopted by

the General Assembly of the United Nations on 15 December 1997.

12 International Convention for the Suppression of the Financing of Terrorism,

adopted by the General Assembly of the United Nations on 9 December 1999.

1607

TOURIST AUTHORITY ACT 1995

1995/200 – 2 November 1995

15 Powers of the Authority

16 Authority to give effect to directions of

Government

PART 3

FINANCIAL

17 Remuneration and allowances of members

of the Board

18 Application of fees

19 Niue Tourist Authority Account

20 Preparation of estimates

21 Authorisation of expenditure

22 Annual reports and accounts

PART 4

MISCELLANEOUS

23 Breach of Act or regulations

24 Regulations

25-26 [Spent]

To reconstitute the Tourist Authority Board as a Tourist Authority

1 Short title

This is the Tourist Authority Act 1995.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“accommodation premises” means and includes hotels, motels, guesthouse,
boarding houses and all land, buildings and premises used wholly or
partly, or intended to be used wholly or partly to provide lodgings for
tourists;
“appointed member” means any member of the Board appointed under
section 4(2)(a);
“Authority” means the Tourist Authority established under section 3;
“Board” means the Board of Directors of the Authority established under
section 12;
“Director” means the Director appointed under section 12;
“Member” means a member of the Board;
“Minister” means the Minister of Tourism;
1608 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“tourism” means the provision of scenic attractions, recreational activities and services that attract tourists;
“tourism industry” means and includes, not only accommodation, but tour operators, inbound operators, travel agents and airline agents.
PART 1
TOURIST AUTHORITY

3 Establishment of Tourist Authority

(1) There shall continue to be an Authority to be called the Tourist Authority.
(2) The Authority shall be a body corporate with perpetual succession and
a common seal capable of suing and being sued and of doing and suffering all
such acts and things as bodies corporate may lawfully do and suffer.

4 Board of Directors

(1) There shall be a Board of Directors of the Authority which shall, subject
to this Act, have overall control of the Authority.
(2) The Board shall consist of –
(a) Six appointed members, being persons from among those of
competence and experience in –
(i) The tourism industry; and
(ii) Private commercial interests and having personal attributes,
qualifications and experience as will enable those persons to
represent the tourist industry as well as the general community
interests;
(b) The Financial Secretary or an official of the Treasury nominated by
the Financial Secretary who shall be an ex-officio member;
(c) The Director who shall be an ex officio member with no voting
rights.
(3) The appointed members of the Board shall be appointed by Cabinet.
Cabinet shall from among those appointed members appoint one as Chairperson
of the Board.
(4) The powers of the Board shall not be affected by any extraordinary
vacancy in its membership.

5 Term of office of members of Authority

(1) Except as otherwise provided in this Act every appointed member shall
hold office for a term of 3 years but may be reappointed.
(2) Notwithstanding anything in this Act, every appointed member whose
office is terminated by effluxion of time shall continue to hold office until his
successor comes into office.

6 Extraordinary vacancies

(1) An appointed member of the Board may resign his office at any time
by written notice given to the Minister.
(2) An appointed member may at any time be removed from office by
Cabinet for disability, bankruptcy, neglect of duty or misconduct proved to the
satisfaction of Cabinet.
(3) If an appointed member dies or resigns his office by written notice given
to the Minister or is removed from office the vacancy shall be deemed to be an
extraordinary vacancy.
(4) In the case of an extraordinary vacancy, Cabinet may subject to the
criteria for the composition of the Board set forth in section 4(2) appoint any person
to fill the vacancy.

Tourist Authority Act 1995

1609
(5) Any appointed member appointed to fill an extraordinary vacancy shall hold office only for the unexpired portion of the term of office of his predecessor, but may be reappointed.

7 Meetings of Board

(1) The first meeting of the Board shall be held on a day to be appointed by
the Chairperson.
(2) Subsequent meetings shall be held at such times and places as the Board
or the Chairperson may appoint.
(3) The Chairperson or any 2 members may at any time call a special
meeting of the Board with 3 days notice.
(4) At all meetings a majority of the members for the time being of the
Board shall form a quorum.
(5) The Chairperson shall preside at all meetings at which he is present. In
the absence of the Chairperson from any meeting, the members present shall
appoint one of their number to be Chairperson of that meeting.
(6) At any meeting the Chairperson shall have a deliberative vote and in
the case of an equality of votes shall also have a casting vote.
(7) All questions arising at any meeting shall be decided by a majority of
the valid votes of members recorded on it.
(8) The Minister should request the right to attend and address any meeting
of the Board, but not to be present during voting.
(9) Subject to this Act and of any regulations made under it, the Board
may regulate its procedure in such manner as it thinks fit.

8 Minutes of meetings

(1) The Board shall cause minutes to be kept in a book provided for the
purpose, of all resolutions and proceedings of its meetings.
(2) The minutes shall be signed by the Chairperson at the next meeting.
(3) A copy of the minutes of every meeting shall be furnished to every member.

9 Disclosure of conflicting interest

(1) Any member who has a direct or indirect pecuniary interest in any
matter before the Board or any committee of it (apart from any interest in common
with the public or with any section of the public or with any section of the tourist
industry affected by the matter in question) shall as soon as possible after the
relevant facts have come to his notice, disclose the nature of his interest at a meeting
of the Board.
(2) A disclosure under this section shall be recorded in the minutes of the
meeting of the Board and the member shall not take part after the disclosure in
any deliberation or decisions relating to the matter, but shall be counted as present
for the purpose of forming a quorum of the Board for any such deliberation or
decision.

10 Board may refer matters for investigation

The Board may appoint one or more of its members or any other qualified
person to investigate and report to the Board on such matters as are referred to
him or them by the Board for the purpose of the proper exercise of its powers or
functions under this Act.
1610 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

11 Delegation of powers of Authority

(1) The Authority may appoint a committee or committees consisting of 2
or more persons being members of the Board or officers of the Authority and may
delegate to any such committee any of the powers or functions of the Authority
except for the power of delegation conferred by this section.
(2) The Authority may delegate any of its powers to any member of the
Board or officer or employee of the Authority except for the power of delegation
conferred by this section.
(3) Subject to any general or special directions given or conditions imposed
by the Authority or committee or person to whom any powers are delegated under
this section the committee or person to whom any powers are so delegated may
exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same effect as if they had
been conferred directly by this Act and not by delegation.
(4) Every committee or person purporting to act under any delegation
under this section shall be presumed to be acting under the terms of the delegation
in the absence of proof to the contrary.
(5) Any delegation under this section may be made to a specified person
or to persons of a specified class or may be made to the holder for the time being
of a specified office or appointment or to the holders of officer or appointments of
a specified class.
(6) Any delegation under this section may be revoked at any time.
(7) The delegation of any power by the Authority shall not prevent the
exercise of that power by the Authority.

12 Director and other employees

(1) The Authority shall appoint a Director of Tourism who shall be the
Chief Executive Officer of the Authority.
(2) The Director in consultation with the Authority may appoint such other
officers and employees including acting or temporary or casual officers and
employees as it thinks necessary for the efficient exercise of its functions and
powers.
(3) Any person in the service of the Crown may be appointed to be an
officer or employee of the Authority but no such person shall be entitled to hold
office concurrently as an officer or employee of the Authority and as a servant of
the Crown except in the case of a person subject to the Public Service Commission,
with the consent of the Commission.
(4) Subject to this Act the Authority may employ a Director of Tourism
and other employees upon such terms and conditions and at such salaries and
allowances as it thinks fit and may at any time remove any officer or employee
from his office or employment.
(5) No person by reason only of being a director or employee of the
Authority shall be deemed to be employed in the Public Service except that for
the purpose of a government superannuation service as an officer or employee
appointed under this Act shall be deemed to be Government Service.
PART 2
OBJECTIVES, FUNCTIONS AND POWERS

13 Objectives of the Authority

The primary objective of the Authority shall be to encourage and promote
the development of tourism in Niue in a manner which is appropriate to the
interests of developing Niue as a tourist destination having regard also to the
community at large and the objectives of Government as set out in the Niue
Strategic Plan as promulgated from time to time.

Tourist Authority Act 1995

1611

14 Functions of Authority

In pursuance of its objective the Authority shall have the following
functions –
(a) As to policy and planning –
(i) To recommend for Cabinet approval national and regional
policy for the development, promotion, regulation and control
of tourism;
(ii) To assist, and advise the Minister, in the implementation of
national and regional tourism policy;
(iii) To co-ordinate policy and planning for the development and
promotion of tourism;
(iv) To undertake such planning and research (not being undertaken
by any other agency or department of the Government) as may
be required to provide the Minister with advice and guidance
on matters of policy and planning affecting the tourist industry;
(v) To undertake such planning and research as may be required
to enable the Authority to discharge any other of its functions
under this section;
(b) As to marketing and promotion –
(i) To promote and encourage travel by the public to Niue under
policies as established;
(ii) To promote and encourage the development of those tourism
facilities, attractions and services which are consistent with the
requirements of the tourist industry from time to time;
(iii) To provide and co-ordinate national destination and other
broad-spectrum marketing services as may be required to
ensure orderly promotion of tourism in overseas markets;
(iv) To provide advisory and guidance services for travel agents,
tour operators and others engaged in the business of
encouraging tourists to visit Niue;
(v) To establish, maintain, develop and operate publicity, public
relations and information services in respect of travel to Niue;
(c) As to cultural and community issues –
(i) To establish and promote structures and procedures to facilitate
dialogue and consultation on matters affecting tourism between
and among the Government, those involved in the tourism
industry in Niue and the general public of Niue;
(ii) To identify and promote those aspects of Niuean culture and
entertainment of interest to tourists;
(iii) To advise and inform the Minister as required of matters of
particular community concern;
(iv) To regulate and control in conjunction with other departments
and agencies of the Government the use, development and
maintenance of scenic attractions and recreational facilities,
standards and licensing of accommodation and inbound
operators in Niue;
(v) Tourism projects should be subject to environmental impact
assessments and authority should have regard to the Niue
environment management strategy and other Government
policies concerning the environment;
1612 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(d) As to education and training –
(i) To promote and co-ordinate with other departments and
agencies of the Government an ongoing programme of
education and training to improve levels of participation by
Niueans and permanent residents of Niue in the tourist
industry;
(ii) To establish and promote a continuing programme of
community education as to the benefits and advantages of
tourism;
(e) As to general administration and other matters –
(i) To hold such inquiries and gather such information as will
enable it to determine the requirements of tourists and the
public as to the provision of services of all kinds and other
amenities on premises licensed under this Act;
(ii) To conduct enquiries into any matters at the request of or with
the approval of the Minister and to make recommendations to
the Minister in respect of them;
(iii) To do such other acts and things as the Authority may be
required or authorised to do by this or any other Act or as may
in the opinion of the Authority be necessary or desirable for
the purposes of this Act.

15 Powers of the Authority

The Authority shall have all the powers reasonably necessary for the
effective performance of its functions –
(a) Subject to the provisions of any enactment applicable to the
Authority, fix regulate or make such charges as it determines for
the use of service, works, recreation grounds, equipment, apparatus,
attractions, amenities or facilities provided, maintained, controlled,
or operated by the Authority;
(b) Contract for the execution or provision by any person of any work
or services authorised by this or any other Act to be executed or
provided by the Authority in such manner and on and subject to
such terms and conditions as the Authority thinks fit;
(c) For the purpose of promoting and encouraging tourist traffic to
Niue, act in combination or association with any person or body of
persons whether incorporated or not and whether in Niue or
elsewhere or any Government department or agency that may be
engaged, concerned or interested in the promotion of tourist traffic
from overseas and contribute to the expenses involved in any such
combination or association;
(d) To make recommendations to the Minister to regulate on standards
to be complied with by hotels, accommodation, premises,
restaurants, scenic attractions and recreational facilities together
with services and amenities, in connection with them.

16 Authority to give effect to directions of Government

(1) In the exercise of its functions and powers the Authority shall have
regard to any general policy directions that may be made by Cabinet and conveyed
to it by the Minister in respect of any functions or activities of the Authority and
shall give effect to any decision of the Government in relation to it conveyed to
the Authority in writing by the Minister.

Tourist Authority Act 1995

1613
(2) A copy of every written directive from the Cabinet shall be included in the annual report required to be made by the Authority to Cabinet under section
22.
PART 3
FINANCIAL

17 Remuneration and allowances of members of the Board

The members of the Board shall be paid out of the Niue Tourist Authority
account.

18 Application of fees

All fees and other moneys paid under this Act shall be paid into the Niue
Tourist Authority account and all expenses incurred in respect of the administration
of this Act and regulations under it shall be paid out of such moneys as may be
appropriated by the Assembly.

19 Niue Tourist Authority Account

(1) The Authority shall keep such bank account or accounts as may be
approved by the Board.
(2) No money shall be withdrawn from any bank account except by cheque
or other instrument (not being a promissory note or bill) signed by such person or
persons in such manner as the Board may determine.

20 Preparation of estimates

(1) The Authority shall in each year prepare and submit annual estimates
of revenue and expenditure, as the Minister responsible for finance directs, covering
the operations of the Authority in the exercise of its powers and functions.
(2) The estimates may in respect of any undertaking of the Authority
provide for finance by way of loans or overdraft the terms and conditions of which
shall be subject to the approval of Cabinet.
(3) The Minister shall submit the estimates, with such recommendations
to Cabinet for approval.
(4) A copy of the estimates as approved by Cabinet shall be attached to the
estimates prepared under section 14 of the Public Revenues Act 1959 as an
appendix.

21 Authorisation of expenditure

(1) The Board may authorise expenditure in accordance with the estimates
approved by the Assembly and as between items of expenditure in the approved
estimates may, with the approval of the Cabinet exercise a power of virement to
an extent not exceeding 20 per cent of the item to which funds are transferred.
(2) The Cabinet may authorise expenditure in excess of the total provided
for in the estimates to the extent that receipts of the Authority exceed the amount
estimated.

22 Annual report and accounts

(1) The Authority shall, as soon as practicable after 30 June in each year,
furnish a report covering its activities for the year ending on 30 June, including
financial statements showing estimates and actual expenditure and receipts
together with such accounts as are appropriate to the nature of its financial
operations.
1614 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) The financial statements required to be furnished to the Minister under subsection (1) shall be in such form as may be directed by the Minister responsible for finance and shall be completed and available no later than 2 months after the end of the financial year to which they relate.
PART 4
MISCELLANEOUS

23 Breach of Act or regulations

Every person who commits or attempts to commit or is concerned in
committing or attempting to commit a breach or violation of this Act or of any
regulations made under this Act for which no special penalty is provided is liable
for every offence to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units and if the breach or
violation is a continuing one to a further fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit for
every day or part of a day during which the offence continues.

24 Regulations

(1) The Cabinet may make all such regulations as may be necessary or
expedient for giving effect to this Act and for the due administration of it.
(2) All such regulations shall be laid before the Assembly within 28 days
after the making of it if the Assembly is then in session, and, if not, shall be laid
before the Assembly at the commencement of the next ensuing session.

25-26 [Spent]

1615

TRANSPORT ACT 1965

1965/30 – 1 July 1965

1 Short title

2 –

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

30 Overtaking involving risk prohibited

31 Right-hand turn at intersection

32 Driver of vehicle to yield the right of way

33 Unsafe vehicles

3 Interpretation

PART 2

34 Dangerous riding on vehicles

35 Motor driver ’s visible signals

36 Parking of motor vehicles

REGISTRATION AND ANNUAL LICENCES

4 Use of motor vehicles prohibited unless

Part 2 complied with

5 Penalty for contravention

6 Registrar and Register

7 Application for registration

8 Pneumatic tyres and right hand drive

required

9 Procedure for registration

10 Issue and use of registration plates

11 Registration in force subject to cancellation

12 Registration fees

13 Duty of owner to obtain annual licence

14 Application for annual licence

15 Fees for annual licence

16 Issue of annual licence and duty to produce

licence on demand

17 Cancellation of registration

18 Change of ownership

PART 3

LICENSING OF MOTOR VEHICLES

19 Unlicensed persons not to drive

20 Application for driver ’s licence

20A Prohibitions relating to driving licences

21 Fees for driver ’s licence

22 Procedure of licensing

23 Fees for driving test

24 Expiration and renewal of licence

25 L plates

26 Charge for registration plates

27 Driver to produce his licence on demand

PART 4

RULES OF THE ROAD

28 Vehicles to keep to the left

29 Driver of vehicle to give audible signal

when overtaking

37 Towing of motor vehicles and leading of

animals

38 Number of persons on motor cycles and

power cycles and requirements as to safety

helmets

38A Safety helmets for motorcyclists

PART 5

RECKLESS OR INTOXICATED DRIVERS

39 Penalties for causing death or bodily injury

through reckless or negligent driving or

through driving while intoxicated

40 Penalties for reckless or negligent driving

or driving while intoxicated

41 Constable may take steps to prevent

incapable person from driving

42 Duties of motor drivers in cases of accident

43 Arrest without warrant

44 Cancellation or suspension of licence or

disqualification and endorsement of licence

45 Penalties for driving while licence cancelled

or while disqualified

45A Limited licences

PART 5A

PRESCRIBED ALCOHOL AND DRUG LEVELS

45AA Driving with excessive breath-alcohol or

blood-alcohol

45B Breath tests

45C Provision of specimens for evidential

analysis

45D Protection for hospital patients

45E Evidence

45F Detention of persons affected by alcohol or

a drug

45G Provision of specimens

45H Sentencing of offenders

1616 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

79 Maintenance of traffic signs

80 Offences against Part 9

PART 10

PUBLIC PLACES TO BE KEPT FREE FROM OBSTRUCTIONS

81 Trimming of hedges and trees on adjacent

land

82 Weeding on roads

83 Keeping public places tidy and safe

PART 11

BICYCLES

84 Bicycles to comply with special

requirements

85 Headlamps

86 Rear reflectors

87 Prohibited lights

88 Brakes

89 Special equipment if infant taken for a ride

90 Riding prohibited on footpaths and over

cultivated land

91 Towing prohibited

92 Warning signal before right-hand turn

93 Riding in batches restricted

94 Dangerous riding

PART 12

PASSENGER SERVICES

95 No liquor on public transport

96 Speed limit for trucks carrying passengers

97 –

PART 13

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

98 Approval of equipment for a transition

period and exemptions from equipment

requirements

99 Compensation for conversion

100 Unlawful interference with vehicle

101 Powers of Police

102 Offences

103 General penalties

104 Act to bind the Crown

105 [Spent]

106 Application of fees and fines

107 Regulations

SCHEDULE

Transport Act 1965 1617

To consolidate and amend various Acts relating to the control of vehicles, roads and road traffic

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Transport Act 1965.

2 –

3 Interpretation

In this Act –
“approved” means approved by the Chief Officer of Police;
“approved device” means a breathtest device approved by the Cabinet
under section 45G(5);
“bicycle” includes a tricycle driven with pedals;
“breath test” means a test for the purpose of obtaining, by means of an
approved device, a measurement that the proportion of alcohol in a
person’s breath exceeds the prescribed limit or that the proportion of
alcohol in a person’s blood is likely to exceed the prescribed limit;
“driver” includes the rider of a motorcycle or power cycle or pedal cycle;
“drug” includes any intoxicant other than alcohol;
“fail” includes refuse;
“goods” includes animals and mail;
“heavy motor vehicle” means a motor vehicle (other than a motor car that
is not used, kept, or available for the carriage of passengers for hire or
reward) the gross weight of which exceeds 2,000 kilograms;
“hospital” means an institution which provides medical or surgical
treatment for in-patients or out-patients;
“hours of darkness” means –
(a) the period of time between half an hour after sunset on any one
day and half an hour before sunrise on the next following day;
(b) Any other time when there is insufficient daylight to render clearly
visible a person or vehicle at a distance of 150 feet;
“in charge of a motor vehicle” means to be seated in the motor vehicle with
the intention of driving it or outside the motor vehicle attending to the
mechanics or otherwise preparing to drive it;
“left side” in relation to a vehicle means its side to the left of the driver ’s
seat when facing forward;
“licensing year” means the year expiring on 31 March following the issue
of an annual licence under Part 2;
“motor car” means a motor vehicle other than a motor cycle or power cycle
designed exclusively or principally for the carriage of persons not
exceeding 7 in number inclusive of the driver;
“motor cycle” means a motor vehicle running on 2 wheels or not more
than 3 wheels when fitted with a sidecar, but does not include a power
cycle;
“motor vehicle” means a vehicle that is drawn or propelled by mechanical
power and includes a trailer and a tractor but does not include a vehicle
normally propelled by mechanical power while it is being temporarily
towed without the use of its own power;
1618 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“operate” means use or drive or ride or cause or permit to be driven or ridden or permit to be in any public place whether the person operating is present in person or not;
“owner” includes a bailee to whom a motor vehicle is bailed for any period exceeding 14 days and also includes a person in possession of a motor vehicle pursuant to a bill of sale; and where there are more owners of a motor vehicle than one, every such owner shall be deemed to be an owner for the purposes of this Act;
“passenger service vehicle” means a motor vehicle used for the carriage of
passengers for hire or reward;
“power cycle” means a pedal bicycle or tricycle that for alternative
propulsion is fitted with a motor attachment (whether detachable or
not);
“prescribed limit” means as the case may require –
(a) 35 micrograms of alcohol in 100 millilitres of breath; or
(b) 80 milligrams of alcohol in 100 millilitres of blood;
“Registrar” means a Registrar of Motor Vehicles appointed under this Act;
“registration plate” means a registration plate for a motor vehicle issued
under Parts 2 and 3;
“right of way” means the right of precedence in continuing on a course;
“right side” in relation to a vehicle means its side to the right of the driver ’s
seat when facing forward;
“taxicab” means a motor vehicle which –
(a) Is designed exclusively or principally for the carriage of persons
not exceeding 8 in number inclusive of the driver; and
(b) Is used for hire or reward for the carriage of passengers otherwise
than on defined routes; and
(c) Is available for hire to any member of the public;
“tractor” means a motor vehicle that is designed exclusively for the
purposes of traction and not for the carriage of passengers (other than
the driver) or of goods;
“trade motor” means any motor vehicle other than a motorcar, motor cycle,
power cycle or trailer;
“trailer” means a vehicle without motive power that is drawn or propelled
or is capable of being drawn or propelled by a motor vehicle from which
it is readily detachable, but does not include a side car attached to a
motor cycle;
“use” in relation to a vehicle includes driving, drawing or propelling by
means of another vehicle and permitting to be in any public place;
“vehicle” means a contrivance that is equipped with wheels or revolving
runners upon which it moves or is moved.
PART 2
REGISTRATION AND ANNUAL LICENCES

4 Use of motor vehicles prohibited unless Part 2 complied with

Except as specially provided in this Act, no person shall in any licensing
year knowingly use any motor vehicle in any public place, or permit any motor vehicle to be so used unless –
(a) The motor vehicle is registered under this Act;
(b) A licence to use the motor vehicle for that licensing year has been
issued;
(c) Registration plates for the motor vehicle have been issued and are
affixed to it in the manner prescribed in this Act.

Transport Act 1965 1619

5 Penalty for contravention

(1) Every person who knowingly uses or permits to be used a motor vehicle
in any public place without having it registered and licensed as required by this
Act or, having it so registered and licensed, without having registration plates
bearing the assigned registration number, duly affixed to it and every person who
wilfully or negligently defaces any registration plate so affixed commits an offence
and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(2) The fact that any motor vehicle is used in any public place without
having registration plates affixed to it in the prescribed manner shall be sufficient
evidence until the contrary is proved, that the motor vehicle has not been registered
and licensed under this Act.

6 Registrar and Register

(1) There shall be appointed a Registrar of Motor Vehicles for the purposes
of this Act.
(2) The Registrar shall compile and keep up to date at his office a register
of all motor vehicles registered and of all registration plates and licences issued
and also of the fees received in respect of it.

7 Application for registration

Application for the registration of any motor vehicle shall be made in the
form numbered 1 in the Schedule or to the effect of it.

8 Pneumatic tyres and right hand drive required

Except with the written permission of Cabinet, no motor vehicle shall be
registered under this Act unless all the wheels of it are fitted with pneumatic tyres
and, where applicable, the motor vehicle has a right hand drive.

9 Procedure for registration

(1) On receipt of an application for registration of any motor vehicle under
this Act the Registrar, if satisfied that the application is in order, shall assign a
number to the motor vehicle to be shown on the motor vehicle, and shall issue to
the applicant a certificate of registration of the motor vehicle in the form numbered
2 in the Schedule.
(2) The certificate of registration shall in the case of a trade motor specify
the number of persons excluding the driver which the trade motor may lawfully
carry at any one time, and shall also specify the maximum weight of goods or
passengers or both which the trade motor may lawfully carry at any one time.
(3) No person shall drive a trade motor which is carrying at any one time
a greater number of persons or a weight exceeding the maximum weight of goods
or passengers or both specified in the certificate of registration under subsection
(2).

10 Issue and use of registration plates

(1) On completion of the registration and on the issue of an annual licence
as hereinafter provided, the Registrar shall supply to the owner of the motor vehicle
appropriate registration plates on which every letter and figure shall be not less
than 3 inches in height.
(2) Subject to subsection (1) all registration plates shall be of approved
designs, colours, and distinguishing marks.
1620 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) (a) The number assigned to the motor vehicle by the registration shall be shown on 2 registration plates so supplied which shall be affixed one on the front and the other on the back of the motor vehicle in an upright position so that every letter and figure on the plate is upright and easily distinguishable.
(b) In the case of a power cycle or a trailer only one registration plate
shall be affixed to the back of that motor vehicle in the manner
hereinbefore described.

11 Registration in force subject to cancellation

Save as provided in this Act with respect to the cancellation of registration
in special cases, the registration of any motor vehicle shall continue in force without
renewal.

12 Registration fees

(1) There shall be payable for the registration of any motor vehicle such
fees as Cabinet may prescribe by regulation.
(2) (a) Every application for the registration of a motor vehicle shall be
accompanied by the amount of the appropriate fee.
(b) No fee shall be payable for the registration of any motor vehicle
owned by the Government.

13 Duty of owner to obtain annual licence

(1) Save with respect to motor vehicles owned by the Government every
owner of a motor vehicle shall obtain annually from the Registrar a licence to use
the motor vehicle.
(2) Every such licence shall expire on 31 March following the issue of it
and application for renewal of any licence so expiring shall be made on or before
the date of expiration.
(3) No annual licence shall be issued in respect of any motor vehicle which
has not been duly registered under this Act.

14 Application for annual licence

Subject to section 16(1), application for a licence shall be made in the form
numbered 3 in the Schedule and the first such application shall be made together
with the application for registration.

15 Fees for annual licence

(1) (a) There shall be payable for the issue of every annual licence for any
motor vehicle such fees as Cabinet may prescribe by regulation.
(b) In the case of a licence issued for a period less than a year the
prescribed licence fee shall be reduced by one-twelfth for every
complete month by which that period is less than one year.
(2) Every application for an annual licence shall be accompanied by the
amount of the appropriate fee.

16 Issue of annual licence and duty to produce licence on demand

(1) (a) The Registrar shall thereupon issue in the form numbered 4 in the
Schedule a licence to use the motor vehicle.
(b) With respect to the renewal of any annual licence the Registrar may
accept and issue applications and licences in a simplified form
approved by Cabinet.

Transport Act 1965 1621

(2) While any such licence is in force and registration plates are affixed as prescribed the motor vehicle may be used in any public place on Niue during the licensing year for which the licence was issued.
(3) Every person operating any motor vehicle shall produce the annual licence for inspection whenever required so to do by any constable.

17 Cancellation of registration

(1) If any registered motor vehicle is destroyed or becomes permanently
useless as a motor vehicle or is intended to be removed from Niue the owner shall
forthwith give to the Registrar notice of that destruction, condition or removal, as
the case may be, and shall deliver to the Registrar the certificate of registration
and the licence issued for the then current licensing year and, if practicable, the
registration plates issued and the Registrar shall thereupon cancel the registration
of the motor vehicle and the annual licence.
(2) On the cancellation of registration and licence as aforesaid Cabinet may
cause to be refunded by the Treasurer of Niue to the owner such sum as it thinks
proper not exceeding one-twelfth part of the annual licence fee for every complete
month between the date of cancellation of the licence and the end of the period for
which the licence fee was paid.
(3) When the registration of a motor vehicle is cancelled the Registrar may
assign to any other motor vehicle thereafter registered the number of the motor
vehicle the registration whereof has been cancelled, if the registration plates
assigned to that vehicle have been delivered or the Registrar is satisfied that no
confusion is likely to arise from the assignment of the same number.

18 Change of ownership

(1) Within 7 days after the sale or other disposal of a motor vehicle the
person selling it or otherwise disposing of it shall deliver to the Registrar the
certificate of registration and the licence issued for the then current licensing year
in respect of that motor vehicle and the Registrar shall endorse on the certificate
and licence a memorandum of the change of ownership, and shall on the payment
of a fee of $10 issue the endorsed certificate and licence to the new owner.
(2) No person who becomes the owner of any motor vehicle under any
sale or other disposal as aforesaid shall use or permit to use the motor vehicle in
any public place unless and until he has received the endorsed certificate and
licence.
PART 3
LICENSING OF MOTOR DRIVERS

19 Unlicensed persons not to drive

(1) Except as otherwise provided in this section it shall not be lawful for
any person to drive a motor vehicle in any public place unless he is the holder of
a motor driver ’s licence issued under this Part and for the time being in force and
no person shall employ any other person so as to drive a motor vehicle unless the
person so employed is the holder of a driver ’s licence as aforesaid.
(2) Any person who acts in contravention of this section commits an offence
and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(3) Subject to subsection (4), where any person (in this section called “the
learner”) is driving a motor vehicle and is accompanied by a person seated
alongside him who is teaching the learner to drive and who is the holder of a
driver ’s licence for the time being in force which authorises him to drive a motor
vehicle of that class in a public place, the learner and any person permitting the
1622 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
learner to drive the motor vehicle shall be deemed not to be acting in contravention of subsection (1).
(4) Nothing in subsection (3) applies in any case where –
(a) The learner has not attained the age that qualifies him to obtain a
driver ’s licence to drive the motor vehicle that he is driving; or
(b) The learner is subject to an order that disqualifies him from holding
or obtaining a driver ’s licence.

20 Application for driver’s licence

Subject to section 22(2) application for a motor driver ’s licence shall be
made in the form numbered 5 in Schedule 1 or to the effect thereof and every such
application shall clearly state the class or classes of motor vehicles in respect of
which the licence is applied for.

20A Prohibitions relating to drivers’ licences

(1) No person who is under the age of 14 years shall apply for or obtain a
driver ’s licence, and any licence that is so obtained by any such person shall be of
no effect.
(2) No person who is under the age of 18 years shall apply for or obtain a
licence to drive a heavy motor vehicle, and any such licence that is so obtained
shall be of no effect.
(3) No person who is under the age of 20 years shall apply for or obtain a
licence to drive a passenger service vehicle, and any such licence that is so obtained
shall be of no effect.
(4) An application for a licence to drive a passenger service vehicle must
be accompanied by a medical certificate certifying the applicant medically fit to
drive.

21 Fees for driver’s licence

There shall be payable for the issue of a driver ’s licence such fees as Cabinet
may prescribe by regulation and every application for a licence shall be
accompanied by the amount of the appropriate fee.

22 Procedure of licensing

(1) On receipt of an application as aforesaid the Registrar shall issue a
driver ’s licence to any applicant who satisfies him –
(a) That the applicant is over the age of 14 years; and
(b) That by practical test and oral examination or by other satisfactory
evidence of fitness, the applicant is competent to drive the class or
classes of motor vehicles in respect of which the licence is applied
for; and
(c) That, where the applicant is 65 or more years of age or where the
Registrar considers it advisable, the applicant shall have obtained
a certificate of physical fitness from a Medical Officer;
(d) Cabinet may exempt any person or class of persons generally or
otherwise from the requirements of this section.
(2) (a) Every driver ’s licence shall be issued in the form numbered 6 in
the Schedule.
(b) With respect to the renewal of any driver ’s licence the Registrar
may accept and issue applications and licences in a simplified form
approved by Cabinet.

Transport Act 1965 1623

23 Fees for driving test

Where any applicant is required under this Part to undergo any practical
driving test there shall be payable to the Department by which the test is carried
out a testing fee of such sum as Cabinet may prescribe by regulation and such
testing fee shall be payable whether or not a driver ’s licence is issued to the
applicant.

24 Expiration and renewal of licence

(1) If not earlier cancelled or suspended as provided in this Act every
driver ’s licence shall expire on 31 March following the date of issue and application
for renewal of any licence so expiring shall be made on or before the date of
expiration.
(2) Any motor driver ’s licence may be cancelled at any time by the Registrar
upon receipt of a certificate from a Medical Officer that the holder is no longer
physically fit to drive a motor vehicle of the class or classes for which he had
obtained a driver ’s licence.

25 L plates

Every driver of a motor cycle issued with a driver ’s licence for the first
time shall for 3 months or longer if the examining officer thinks necessary, display
on his motor cycle an L plate (Learner ’s registration plate) to be supplied by the
Registrar, and during this time he shall carry no passengers on his motor cycle.

26 Charge for registration plates

Except with respect to registration plates issued to the Government, a charge
sufficient to cover the cost of any plates issued by the Registrar may be made on
their issue.

27 Driver to produce his licence on demand

Every person driving any motor vehicle shall have his driver ’s licence with
him and shall produce the same for inspection whenever required so to do by any
constable.
PART 4
RULES OF THE ROAD

28 Vehicles to keep to the left

Every driver of a vehicle shall keep the vehicle as close as is practicable to
the side of the roadway on his left.

29 Driver of vehicle to give audible signal when overtaking

Every driver of a vehicle shall, when overtaking any other vehicle, signal
by use of the horn or other sounding device and then pass on his right or off side
of the overtaken vehicle, and shall not then move into the line of passage of the
other vehicle until clear from it by at least 18 feet.

30 Overtaking involving risk prohibited

No driver of any vehicle shall overtake or attempt to overtake any other
vehicle proceeding in the same direction –
(a) At any intersection, or within a distance of 100 feet before an
intersection;
(b) Unless the driver has a clear view of the road and traffic on it for a
distance of at least 300 feet in the direction in which he is travelling.
1624 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

31 Right-hand turn at intersection

Every driver of a vehicle intending to turn at an intersection from any
roadway into another roadway to his right, shall when approaching and turning,
maintain his position to his left of the centre of the roadway out of which he is
turning until he enters the area of the intersection, and shall then turn into the
roadway which he is entering as directly and quickly as he can with safety.

32 Driver of vehicle to yield the right of way to vehicle on his right

Every driver of a vehicle, when approaching or crossing any intersection
which any other vehicle is approaching or crossing from his right shall, where
there would be a possibility of a collision if both continued on their course, yield
the right of way to such other vehicle and allow the same to pass him, and if
necessary for that purpose stop his vehicle.

33 Unsafe vehicles

No person shall operate any vehicle in such conditions or so loaded or
with a load so unsafely secured as to cause, or to be liable to cause, injury to any
person or animal, or annoyance (by reason of noise or other cause) to any person,
or damage to any property.

34 Dangerous riding on vehicles

No person shall ride, and the driver shall not permit any person to ride, on
any vehicle in a manner or position which may be liable to cause injury to that
person or any other person.

35 Motor driver’s visible signals

Every driver of a motor vehicle, whenever in view of other traffic and unless
prevented by a sudden emergency, shall, before manoeuvring the vehicle in manner
hereinafter described, give reasonable notice of his intention so to do as here
provided –
(a) If he is about to stop or reduce speed –
(i) he shall extend the right arm directly outwards from the right
or off side of the motor vehicle with the upper arm horizontal
and the forearm vertical; or
(ii) if the vehicle is equipped with approved automatic signalling
devices at the rear of the vehicle he may indicate his intention
by means of such devices;
(b) If he is about to turn to his right or about to draw out from the
roadside towards his right, or about to overtake a vehicle travelling
in the same direction –
(i) he shall extend the right arm horizontally outwards from the
right or off side of the vehicle;
(ii) if the vehicle is equipped with approved automatic signalling
devices capable of giving a signal closely corresponding to the
signal described in subparagraph (i) he may indicate his
intention by means of such devices.

36 Parking of motor vehicles

No person shall leave or park any motor vehicle upon any public place
unless the motor vehicle is so located or during the hours of darkness so lighted
that it is not a danger or a nuisance to any person or vehicle in the public place.

Transport Act 1965 1625

37 Towing of motor vehicles and leading of animals

(1) No person shall operate any power cycle or any motor cycle (other
than one to which a side car is attached) for the purpose of towing any trailer.
(2) No person shall operate any motor vehicle for the purpose of towing
any other motor vehicle (except a trailer) unless such other motor vehicle is not in
working order and is being temporarily towed without the use of its own power
for the purpose of being repaired.
(3) No person shall lead or permit to be led any animal by or from any
motor vehicle.

38 Number of persons on motor cycles and power cycles and requirements as to safety helmets

(1) No person shall drive a motor cycle in a public place –
(a) Carrying any person upon the motor cycle in front of the driver; or
(b) Without a side car carrying more than 2 persons inclusive of the
driver, or carrying any person seated otherwise than astride and
facing forward;
(c) With a side car carrying more than 4 persons in all.
(2) No person shall drive a power cycle in a public place while it is carrying
any person other than the driver.

38A Safety helmets for motorcyclists

(1) No person shall drive or be a passenger on a motor cycle unless that
person is wearing an approved safety helmet of a type which has been approved
under subsection (2), and which is securely fastened.
(2) (a) For the purposes of this section, “approved safety helmet” means a
safety helmet for the time being approved by a competent authority
in New Zealand, Australia, Japan or the United States of America.
(b) A helmet which bears the approval mark of such an authority shall
in the absence of evidence to the contrary be deemed to be an
approved safety helmet.
PART 5
RECKLESS OR INTOXICATED DRIVERS

39 Penalties for causing death or bodily injury through reckless or negligent

driving or through driving while intoxicated

(1) Every person commits an offence against this Act who, without being
guilty of the crime of manslaughter as defined in Part 5 of the Niue Act 1966 –
(a) Recklessly or negligently drives any motor vehicle and thereby
causes bodily injury to or the death of any person; or
(b) While under the influence of drink or a drug to such an extent as to
be incapable of having proper control of the motor vehicle, is in
charge of a motor vehicle and by an act or omission in relation to it
causes bodily injury to or the death of any person.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against this section is liable on
conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 5 years or to a fine not
exceeding 15 penalty units or to both, and (without prejudice to the power of the
Court to order a longer period of disqualification) the Court shall order him to be
disqualified from holding or obtaining a driver ’s licence for a period of one year,
unless the Court for special reasons relating to the offence thinks fit to order
otherwise.
1626 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

40 Penalties for reckless or negligent driving or driving while intoxicated

(1) Every person commits an offence who –
(a) Recklessly or negligently drives a motor vehicle in any public place;
or
(b) Drives any motor vehicle at a speed which, having regard to all the
circumstances of the case, is or might be dangerous to the public;
(c) [Repealed by 1997/221]
(d) Drives a vehicle in a manner which having regard to all the
circumstances of the case is or might be dangerous to the public or
any person.
(2) (a) A person who, when driving or attempting to drive a motor vehicle
on a road or other public place, is unfit to drive through drink or
drugs, shall be guilty of an offence.
(b) Without prejudice to paragraph (a), a person who, when in charge
of a motor vehicle which is on a road or other public place is unfit
to drive through drink or drugs, shall be guilty of an offence.
(c) For the purposes of paragraph (b), a person shall be deemed not to
have been in charge of a motor vehicle if he proves that, at the
material time, the circumstances were such that there was no
likelihood of his driving that vehicle so long as he remained unfit
to drive through drink or drugs, but in determining whether there
was such a likelihood the court may disregard any injury to him
and any damage to the vehicle.
(d) For the purposes of this subsection a person shall be taken to be
unfit to drive if his ability to drive properly is for the time being
impaired.
(e) A constable may arrest a person without warrant if he has reasonable
cause to suspect that that person is or has been committing an
offence under this subsection.
(f) For the purpose of arresting a person under the power conferred
by paragraph (e) a constable may enter (if need be by force) any
place where that person is or where the constable, with reasonable
cause, suspects him to be.
(3) Every person commits an offence against this Act and shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units and the Court may order him to
be disqualified from holding or obtaining a driver ’s licence for a period not
exceeding 3 months who drives a motor vehicle in any public place or without
reasonable consideration for other persons using that public place.

41 Constable may take steps to prevent incapable person from driving

(1) Any constable who believes that any person while for the time being in
charge of any motor vehicle is, by reason of physical or mental condition, however
arising, incapable of having proper control of the motor vehicle, may –
(a) Forbid that person to drive the motor vehicle;
(b) Require that person to deliver up forthwith all ignition or other
keys of the motor vehicle in his possession;
(c) Take such steps as may be necessary to render the motor vehicle
immobile or to remove it to a place of safety.
(2) Every person commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to
imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 5
penalty units and further, disqualified from holding or obtaining a driver ’s licence
for up to 3 months who fails to comply with any direction given to him under

Transport Act 1965 1627

subsection (1) or does any act that is for the time being forbidden under that subsection.
(3) No person shall be deemed to have committed an offence under this section unless the Court is satisfied that the constable had reasonable grounds for believing that in all the circumstances of the case the direction or prohibition was necessary in the interests of the defendant or of any other person or of the public.

42 Duties of motor drivers in cases of accident

(1) Where an accident arising directly or indirectly from the use of a motor
vehicle occurs to any person or to any animal or vehicle in charge of any person,
the driver of the motor vehicle shall stop and ascertain whether he has injured
any person and in that event it shall be his duty to render all practicable assistance
to the injured person.
(2) (a) In the case of any such accident (whether any person has been
injured or not) the driver of the motor vehicle shall, if required,
give to any constable or to any person concerned his name and
address and also the name and address of the owner of the motor
vehicle and, if any, the numbers to be shown on the registration
plates and the annual licence of the vehicle.
(b) If the accident involves injury to any person the driver shall report
the accident in person at the nearest Police Station or to any constable
as soon as reasonably practicable, and in any case not later than 24
hours after the accident unless the driver is incapable of doing so
by reason of injuries sustained by him as a result of the accident.
(3) Every driver who fails to comply with any duty imposed on him by
subsection (1) in any case where any other person is injured in the accident commits
an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding one year or to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units and the Court may
order him to be disqualified from holding or obtaining a driver ’s licence for a
period not exceeding 3 months.
(4) Every driver who fails to comply with any duty imposed on him by
subsection (1) in any case where no other person is injured in the accident commits
an offence and shall be liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.
(5) Every person who fails to comply with any duty imposed on him by
subsection (2) commits an offence.
(6) In this section “injury” includes death.

43 Arrest without warrant

(1) Any constable who, on reasonable and probable grounds believes that
any person has committed or attempted to commit an offence against section 41
or 42(1) or that any person, while under the influence of drink or a drug to such an
extent as to be incapable of having proper control of a motor vehicle, has committed
an offence against section 39 or 40(1) or (2) may arrest that person without warrant.
(2) Every driver of a motor vehicle shall stop at the request or signal of
any constable in uniform, and on demand shall give him his name and address,
and, if he is not the owner of the motor vehicle, also the name and address of the
owner.
(3) Any driver who on demand fails to stop, or refuses to give any such name and address, commits an offence and may be arrested by any constable without warrant.
1628 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

44 Cancellation or suspension of licence or disqualification and endorsement of licence

(1) The court before which any person is convicted of an offence against Part 4, 5 or 6 or of any offence in connection with the driving of a motor vehicle (other than a first or second offence consisting solely of exceeding any speed limit) may, in addition to or in lieu of any other penalty inflicted –
(a) If the person convicted holds a motor driver ’s licence, order that the licence of such person be cancelled or suspended for such time as the court thinks fit and may also declare that a person whose licence is so cancelled shall be disqualified from obtaining a motor driver ’s licence for such time as the court thinks fit;
(b) If the person convicted does not hold a motor driver ’s licence,
declare him to be disqualified from obtaining any motor driver ’s
licence or a motor driver ’s licence for specified classes of motor
vehicles for such time as the court thinks fit.
(2) On any conviction involving cancellation or suspension of a motor
driver ’s licence or disqualification of the driver under this section the court shall
cause particulars of the conviction and any order of the court made in connection
with it to be endorsed on the driver ’s licence.

45 Penalties for driving while licence cancelled or while disqualified

Where any person whose motor driver ’s licence is cancelled under this Act
or who is disqualified from obtaining a driver ’s licence, drives a motor vehicle in
any public place while his licence is so cancelled or while he is so disqualified, he
commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5
penalty units and (without prejudice to the power of the court to order a longer
period of disqualification) the court shall order him to be disqualified from holding
or obtaining a driver ’s licence for a period of one year, unless the court for special
reasons relating to the offence thinks fit to order otherwise.

45A Limited licences

(1) Except as provided in subsection (1A) this section applies in respect of
any person who is disqualified by an order made under this Act from holding or
obtaining a driver ’s licence.
(1A) Nothing in this section shall apply to any person who is disqualified
from holding or obtaining a driver ’s licence as a result of a conviction for an
offence –
(a) Against section 39; or
(b) Committed while driving a passenger service vehicle or a heavy
motor vehicle.
(2) Subject to this section, on the making of the order of disqualification or
at any time thereafter, the court, on the application of the person in respect of
whom the order was made, may, if it is satisfied that the order of disqualification
has resulted or will result in extreme hardship to the applicant (whether in relation
to employment or otherwise) or undue hardship to a person other than the
applicant (whether in relation to employment or otherwise), make an order under
this section authorising him to obtain, immediately or after the expiration of such
period as the Court may specify, a driver ’s licence (in this Part referred to as a
limited licence) authorising him to drive to such extent (being the least extent that
is necessary to alleviate that hardship) as the court specifies in the order.

Transport Act 1965 1629

(2A) Unless the court decides in any particular case that compliance with this subsection is impracticable, no order may be made under this section until every person who has made an affidavit filed in support of the application for the order has appeared before the court for examination on the contents of this affidavit. (3) In making an order under this section, the court shall specify in the
order the purpose for which the limited licence is issued, the particular vehicle or
the type of vehicle which may be driven, the days of the week and times at which
that vehicle may be driven, and such other matters as may be necessary to limit
the order to alleviating the hardship which was alleged and proved and may
specify in the order such other matters as the court thinks fit.
(4) If any application under this section is refused, a further application in
respect of the same order shall not be entertained if made within 3 months after
the date of that refusal.
(5) If the court makes an order under this section the constable may,
notwithstanding anything in this Act to the contrary but otherwise subject to this
Act, issue to the person entitled to it a limited licence under the terms of the order.
(6) Where at the time when the Court makes an order under this section
the applicant is the holder of a driver ’s licence which is suspended by virtue of
the order of disqualification and the period of disqualification will expire before
the expiration of the term of the licence, the constable may, instead of issuing a
limited licence, endorse the particulars of the order granting the limited licence
on his existing licence, which shall thereafter have effect as a limited licence.
(7) Where the holder of a limited licence or any person who is authorised
to obtain a limited licence but has not become the holder of such a licence is
convicted of any offence, for which an order of disqualification is imposed, the
limited licence shall be deemed to be revoked or shall not be issued, as the case
may be, and the original order of disqualification shall revive and have effect for
the balance of the term for which it was originally imposed; and, unless the court
orders otherwise, the period of disqualification under the revived order of
disqualification shall run concurrently with the order of disqualification in respect
of the second offence.
(8) The holder of a limited licence that is deemed to be revoked under
subsection (7) shall forthwith, and whether demand is made on him or not,
surrender his licence to the court by which he is convicted or to a member of the
Police.
PART 5A ALCOHOL AND DRUG LEVELS

45AA Driving with excessive breath-alcohol or blood-alcohol

(1) If a person –
(a) Drives or attempts to drive a motor vehicle on a road or other public
place; or
(b) Is in charge of a motor vehicle on a road or other public place,
after consuming so much alcohol that the proportion of it in his breath, or blood
exceeds the prescribed limit he shall be guilty of an offence.
(2) It is a defence for a person charged with an offence under subsection
(1)(b) to prove that, at the time he is alleged to have committed the offence, the
circumstances were such that there was no likelihood of his driving a vehicle whilst
the proportion of alcohol in his breath or blood remained likely to exceed the
prescribed limit; but in determining whether there was such a likelihood the Court
may disregard any injury to him and any damage to the vehicle.
1630 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

45B Breath tests

(1) Where a constable has reasonable cause to suspect –
(a) That a person is driving or attempting to drive or is in charge of a
motor vehicle on a road or other public place; or
(b) That a person has been driving or attempting to drive or has been
in charge of a motor vehicle on a road or other public place,
then that constable may, subject to section 45D, require that person to provide a
specimen of breath for a breath test.
(2) A person who, without reasonable excuse, fails to provide a specimen
of breath for a breath test when required to so under this section, shall be guilty of
an offence.
(3) A constable may arrest a person without warrant if –
(a) As a result of a breath test he has reasonable cause to suspect that
the proportion of alcohol in that person’s breath or blood exceeds
the prescribed limit; or
(b) That person failed to provide a specimen of breath for a breath test
when required to so under this section;
but a person shall not be arrested by virtue of this subsection when he is at a
hospital as a patient.
(4) For the purpose of requiring a person to provide a specimen of breath
for a breath test in a case where he has reasonable cause to suspect that the person
has been involved in an accident involving injury to another person, or of arresting
him in such a case under subsection (3), a constable may enter, if need be by force,
any place where that person is or where the constable, with reasonable cause,
suspects him to be.

45C Provision of specimens for evidential analysis

(1) In the course of an investigation whether a person has committed an
offence under section 40(2) or 45 AA a constable may, subject to this section and
section 45D, require that person:
(a) To provide a specimen of breath for analysis by means of an
approved device; or
(b) To provide a specimen of blood for laboratory analysis.
(2) If a specimen of blood is required by a constable the person shall permit
a registered medical practitioner to take such a specimen of blood unless the
medical practitioner is of the opinion that for medical reasons a specimen of blood
cannot or should not be taken.
(3) A person who, without reasonable excuse, fails to provide a specimen
when required to do so under this section shall be guilty of an offence.
(4) On requiring any person to provide a specimen under this section, a
police officer shall warn him that a failure to provide that specimen may render
him liable to prosecution.

45D Protection for hospital patients

(1) While a person is at a hospital as a patient he shall not be required to
provide a specimen of breath for a breath test or to provide a specimen of blood
for laboratory analysis unless the medical practitioner in immediate charge of his
case has been notified of the proposal to make the requirement, and
(a) If the requirement is then made it shall be for the provision of a
specimen at the hospital; but
(b) If the medical practitioner objects on the ground specified in
subsection (2) then the requirement shall not be made.

Transport Act 1965 1631

(2) The ground on which the medical practitioner may object is that the requirement of the provision of a specimen would be prejudicial to the proper care and treatment of the patient.

45E Evidence

(1) The following provisions apply with respect to proceedings for an
offence under section 40(2) or 45AA.
(2) Evidence of the proportion of alcohol or any drug in the specimen of
breath or blood provided by the accused shall, in all cases, be taken into account
and it shall be assumed that the proportion of alcohol or drugs in the accused’s
breath or blood at the time of the alleged offence was not less than the specimen;
but if the proceedings are for an offence under section 40(2), 45AA or 45B in a case
where the accused is alleged to have been unfit through drink, the assumption
shall not be made if the accused proves –
(a) That he consumed alcohol after he had ceased to drive, or attempted
to drive or to be in charge of a motor vehicle on a road or other
public place and before he provided the specimen; and
(b) That had he not done so the proportion of alcohol in his breath or
blood would not have exceeded the prescribed limit, or if the
proceedings are for an offence under section 40(2), would not have
been such as to impair his ability to drive properly.
(3) It shall be presumed that the result of the analysis of the breath or blood
specimen is correct, unless the contrary is proven.
(4) Where the proportion of alcohol in a specimen of breath or blood
provided by the accused is found to contain less than the prescribed limit, or to be
such as would not render that person unfit to drive, it shall be open to the
prosecutor to prove that, when that person was driving or attempting to drive or
was in charge of a motor vehicle, the concentration of alcohol in his breath or
blood would at that time have been above the prescribed limit, or would at that
time have been at such a concentration as to have rendered that person unfit to
drive.
(5) Evidence of the proportion of alcohol or a drug in the person’s blood may, subject to subsections (7) and (8), be given by whichever of the following is appropriate, that is to say:
(a) A statement automatically produced by the approved device by
which the proportion of alcohol in the person’s breath was
measured, and a certificate signed by a constable (which may but
need not be contained in the same document as the statement) that
the statement relates to a specimen of breath provided by the
accused at the date and time shown in the statement; or
(b) Oral evidence from the operator of the approved device by which
the proportion of alcohol in that person’s breath was measured as
to the breath alcohol concentration reading given by the device,
together with the evidence that the device was a reliable device for
the purposes of this Act; or
(c) A certificate signed by a suitably qualified analyst as to the
proportion of alcohol or any drug found in a specimen of blood
provided by the accused and as identified in the certificate.
(6) Where, at the time a specimen of blood was provided by the accused,
he asked to be supplied with such a specimen, evidence of the proportion of alcohol
or any drug found in the specimen is not admissible on behalf to the prosecution
unless –
1632 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) The specimen in which the alcohol or drug was found is one of two parts into which the specimen provided by the accused was divided at the time it was provided; and
(b) The other part was supplied to the accused.
(7) A document purporting to be such a statement or such a certificate, or
both such a statement and such a certificate, as is mentioned in subsection (5)(a) is
admissible in evidence on behalf of the prosecution in pursuance of this section
only if a copy of it has either, been handed to the accused when the document was
produced, or has been served on him not later than 14 days before the hearing,
and any other document is so admissible only if a copy of it has been served on
the accused not later than 7 days before the hearing.
(8) A copy of the document as defined in subsection (5)(a) or subsection
(5)(c) must be served personally on the defendant or sent by registered post or
recorded delivery service on him.

45F Detention of persons affected by alcohol or a drug

A person required to provide a specimen of breath or blood may be detained
at a police station until it appears to a constable that, were that person then driving
or attempting to drive a motor vehicle on a road he would not be committing an
offence under section 40(2) or 45AA; but
(a) A person shall not be detained under this section if it appears to a
constable that there is no likelihood of his driving or attempting to
drive a motor vehicle whilst his ability to drive properly is impaired
or whilst the proportion of alcohol in his breath or blood exceeds
the prescribed limit; and
(b) A constable shall consult a medical practitioner on any question
arising under this section whether a person’s ability to drive
properly is or might be impaired through drugs and shall act on
the medical practitioner ’s advice.

45G Provision of specimens

(1) A person does not provide a specimen of breath for a breath test or for
analysis to be carried out and provided in such a way as to enable the objective of
the test or analysis to be satisfactorily achieved.
(2) A person provides a specimen of blood if and only if he consents to it
being taken by a suitably qualified person and it is so taken in such quantity and
of such quality as is capable of being properly analysed for the purposes of this
Act.
(3) A “reasonable excuse” for a person’s failure to provide a specimen is only one which would make it physically impossible for that person to supply the required specimen, or where the provision of that specimen would entail an actual and substantial risk to that person’s health.
(4) Where the result or results from the approved device, as is used for the purposes of section 45C(1) (a), is or are given in terms of the blood alcohol concentration then it shall be assumed, in all cases, that the concentration of alcohol in a person’s breath is a factor of 2300 times less than in his arterial blood.
(5) Cabinet approves the following breath test devices –
(a) All breath test devices approved for use by law enforcement
agencies in New Zealand;
(b) All breath test devices manufactured by Lion Laboratories in Wales
and specifically the Lion alcolmeter SD-400P device.

Transport Act 1965 1633

45H Sentencing of offenders

(1) Everyone who commits an offence under section 40(2) or this Part is
liable on conviction to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 6 months or to a
fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or both, and the Court may in addition order
him to be disqualified for holding or obtaining a driver ’s licence for such period
as the Court considers appropriate.
(2) In addition to the penalties specified in subsection (1) the Court may
also upon conviction impose the sentence of community work.
PART 6
SPEED

46 Chief of Police may impose speed limits outside villages

The Chief of Police may by notice published as he thinks fit, declare any
area outside the boundaries of any village to be subject to speed limits for the
purposes of this Part.

47 Speed limits and penalties for exceeding speed limits

(1) (a) Every person commits an offence who –
(i) drives any motor vehicle in any public place within the
boundaries of any village or of any other area where speed
limits are imposed, at a greater speed than 25 miles per hour;
(ii) drives a motor vehicle (except a truck) in any public place other
than aforesaid at a greater speed than 35 miles per hour, and a
truck at a greater speed than 30 miles per hour;
(iii) drives a motor vehicle in any public place at a greater speed
than 15 miles per hour when within 50 yards of the entrance to
any school, church, meeting house or place of entertainment at
a time when people are assembling or leaving.
(b) Nothing in this section shall operate to make lawful in respect of
any place for which a lower speed limit than that fixed by this
section, is duly fixed by this Act or any other enactment for the
time being in force, any speed in excess of that lower limit.
(2) The boundaries of any village shall for the purpose of this section be
the boundaries defined by any enactment for the time being in force or, where no
such enactment is in force or does not apply, by Cabinet and shall be clearly marked
by suitable signs.
(3) Every person who commits an offence against this section shall be liable
on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(4) It shall be a defence to any person charged with an offence against this
section if he was driving a motor vehicle for the purpose of or in connection with –
(a) The execution of his duties as a constable; or
(b) The necessary attendance at fires; or
(c) First aid or other urgent services rendered on behalf of a sick or
injured person.

48 [Repealed by 3/24/1976]

1634 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 7
EQUIPMENT

49 Light for vehicles and motor vehicles

No person shall operate any vehicle during the hours of darkness without
carrying a conspicuous light on the vehicle in such a manner that the light shall be
distinctly visible to persons meeting or following the vehicle.

50 Headlamps for motor vehicles

No person shall operate a motor vehicle (other than a motor cycle, power
cycle, or trailer) unless it is equipped with two headlamps attached to it, which
shall –
(a) Be of approximately equal candle power; and
(b) Display beams of light of sufficient power to enable substantial
objects and the nature of the road surface to be clearly visible during
the hours of darkness under normal driving and atmospheric
conditions to a driver of normal vision at a distance of at least 150
feet directly in front of the vehicle.

51 Headlamps for motor cycles and power cycles

(1) (a) No person shall operate any motor cycle or power cycle unless it is
equipped with one headlamp attached to it which shall conform to
the requirements of section 50 (b).
(b) The minimum distance specified in section 50(b) shall be only 100
feet for power cycles.
(2) No person shall operate any motor cycle having a side car attached
unless the side car is also equipped with a lamp directing a beam of light forward
and being attached to the front of the side car on the side of it farther from the
motor cycle.

52 Dipping of lights

While meeting and passing another vehicle the driver of any motor vehicle
shall dip his headlights.

53 Rear lights and rear reflectors

(1) No person shall operate a motor vehicle unless it is equipped with at
least one rear lamp attached to the rear of the motor vehicle and showing a red
light visible not less than 300 feet to the rearward.
(2) (a) No person shall operate a motor vehicle (other than a motor cycle
or a power cycle) unless it is equipped with 2 red rear reflectors
placed at the back of the motor vehicle so as to reflect directly to the
rear any light shining towards it from rearward of the vehicle.
(b) Such reflectors shall consist of an approved material and shall be
fitted so that they are displayed in a position within 6 inches of the
rear extremity at each side of the motor vehicle.
(3) No person shall operate a motor cycle or power cycle unless it is
equipped with one red rear reflector conforming to subsection (2).

54 Registration plate to be lit up

The registration plate affixed to the rear of every motor vehicle shall be
illuminated by a beam of white light either from the rear light or, where there are
2 rear lights fitted at each side of the motor vehicle from a separate light, and in
every case so arranged that every letter and numeral on the registration plate is
plainly distinguishable under normal atmospheric conditions from a distance of
at least 60 feet.

Transport Act 1965 1635

55 Two independent brakes

No person shall operate a motor vehicle (other than a motor cycle, power
cycle, or a trailer) unless it is equipped with 2 independent brakes, namely –
(a) A footbrake which is capable of bringing to a standstill the motor
vehicle, without assistance from the compression of the engine,
within a distance of 35 feet from a speed of 20 miles per hour upon
a hard, dry, level roadway free of loose material; and
(b) A handbrake which is capable of bringing the vehicle to a standstill
within a distance of 70 feet from a speed of 20 miles per hour upon
a hard, dry, level roadway free of loose material and is also capable
of holding the vehicle at rest on a grade of one in 5.

56 Brakes for heavy trailers

No person shall operate a motor vehicle towing a trailer the weight of which
with its load exceeds 2 tons, unless the trailer is equipped with a brake readily
applicable by the driver from his normal driving position and complying with the
requirements for a footbrake under section 55(a).

57 Brakes for motor cycles

No person shall operate a motor cycle, unless it is equipped with a brake
acting on the rear which is capable of bringing to a standstill the motor cycle
without assistance from the compression of the engine, within a distance of 35
feet from a speed of 20 miles an hour upon a hard, dry, level roadway free of loose
material, and which is capable of easy adjustment.

58 Brakes for power cycles

(1) No person shall operate a power cycle unless it is equipped with a
reliable brake on each road wheel.
(2) If the brake on the rear wheel is hand operated, it shall be readily
operable with the left hand.

59 All brakes to be properly maintained

All brakes shall be maintained so that at all times they are efficient and in
good working order.

60 Sounding devices

No person shall operate a motor vehicle (other than a trailer) unless it is
equipped with an adequately audible warning device, and a trailer unless it is
attached to a motor vehicle so equipped.

61 Bells and sirens prohibited

(1) (a) No person shall operate a motor vehicle equipped with a bell as a
warning device.
(b) A power cycle may be fitted with a bell of an approved type as its
sole warning device.
(2) Except with the written permission of the Cabinet, no person shall
operate a motor vehicle equipped with a siren as a sole or additional warning
device.
1636 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

62 Rear vision mirror

No person shall operate any motor vehicle (other than a trailer) unless it is
equipped with a mirror fitted in an approved position so as to reflect to the driver
a view of the roadway to the rear sufficient for driving requirements.

63 Steering

No person shall operate a motor vehicle unless the steering gear and
associated mechanism is in a safe and efficient working condition.

64 Silencer

No person shall operate any motor vehicle (other than trailer) unless it is
equipped with an approved silencer or silencing device through which the exhaust
is projected.

65 Windscreen protection

(1) No person shall operate any motor vehicle (other than a motor cycle,
power cycle, or a trailer) fitted with a windscreen unless it is equipped with an
efficient mechanically or electrically operated windscreen wiper to prevent
interference with the driver ’s vision by weather conditions.
(2) No person shall drive any motor vehicle fitted with a windscreen
forward of the driver unless such windscreen is at all times kept clean and clear so
that the driver ’s view forward will not be impeded or obstructed.

66 Dangerous fittings

No person shall operate a motor vehicle having affixed to it any ornament,
decoration, or fitting of such a nature and in such a position that it is likely to
cause injury to any person with whom the motor vehicle may collide.

67 Speedometer

No person shall operate a motor vehicle (other than a trailer or a power
cycle) unless it is equipped with an efficient speedometer in good working order.

68 Footrests for motor cycles

No person shall operate a motor cycle unless it is equipped with adequate
footrests for the use of every person carried otherwise than in a side car.

69 Testing authority

PART 8
MOTOR VEHICLE INSPECTION
There shall be for the purposes of this Part a testing authority which shall be the Chief of Police or any Government Department or person authorised in that behalf by Cabinet.

70 Warrant of fitness on half-yearly inspection

(1) No person shall operate a motor vehicle (other than power cycle) unless
there is carried in or on that motor vehicle a warrant of fitness issued in respect of
that motor vehicle and disclosing thereon a date of examination not earlier than 6
months before such operation.
(2) The warrant of fitness shall be in 2 portions as described in the form
numbered 7 in the Schedule and shall be issued by the testing authority.
(3) The manner in which the portion of the warrant of fitness issued to the
owner shall be affixed to the motor vehicle may be prescribed by the Chief of

Transport Act 1965 1637

Police for specified classes of motor vehicles by notice published as the Chief of
Police thinks fit.
(4) The owner of any motor vehicle who fails to affix any warrant of fitness
issued to him in the manner prescribed or removes any warrant that should be
affixed, commits an offence.
(5) The driver or the person in charge of the motor vehicle shall produce
any warrant of fitness not affixed to the motor vehicle, for inspection whenever
required to do so by any constable.

71 [Repealed by 1990/148]

72 Warrant of fitness for duly equipped motor vehicles

No warrant of fitness shall be issued under this Part unless the motor vehicle
for which the warrant is to be issued is equipped as required by this Act.

73 Offence against Part 8

(1) No person shall knowingly operate a motor vehicle in or on which a
warrant of fitness is required to be carried, if the motor vehicle is no longer so
equipped as to justify the issue of a warrant of fitness in terms of the warrant so
required to be carried.
(2) It shall be a defence in any proceedings for an offence against this section
or section 70(1) if the accused proves that the motor vehicle was being operated
solely for the purpose of obtaining a warrant of fitness.

74 Fees for warrants of fitness

There shall be payable to the testing authority for the issue of every warrant
of fitness such fees as Cabinet may prescribe by regulation.

75 Warrant of fitness to be delivered on sale of motor vehicle

Any person who sells a motor vehicle shall deliver to the purchaser at the
time of delivery of the motor vehicle any current warrant of fitness which is not
affixed to the motor vehicle.

76 Inspection of motor vehicles after accidents

The Chief of Police, if in his opinion any motor vehicle which has been
damaged in an accident, has thereby been rendered unsafe for use, may by notice
in writing given to the owner of the motor vehicle direct that the motor vehicle be
not operated until such repairs have been carried out as may be necessary for a
fresh warrant to be issued under this Part.

77 Traffic signs to be erected

PART 9
TRAFFIC SIGNS
The Chief of Police shall cause traffic signs to be erected in any public place where necessary for the operation of this Act.

78 Kind of traffic signs to be determined by Chief of Police

The Chief of Police may determine –
(a) The classes of traffic signs;
(b) The language of traffic signs;
(c) The description of any class of traffic sign;
(d) The material including reflecting material of traffic signs.
1638 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

79 Maintenance of traffic signs

The Chief of Police shall be responsible for the proper maintenance of every
sign.

80 Offences against Part 9

Every person who wilfully or negligently removes, defaces or damages
any traffic sign erected under this Part commits an offence.
PART 10
PUBLIC PLACES TO BE KEPT FREE FROM OBSTRUCTIONS

81 Trimming of hedges and trees on adjacent land

The Chief of Police may request any occupier of land adjacent to any public
place to cut or trim hedges, trees or other herbage on such land that he considers
dangerous to public safety or which obstructs a clear view of the public place.

82 Weeding on roads

(1) Every owner or occupier of land adjacent to any public road shall keep
the part of such road from the boundary of the land to the centre of the road at all
times reasonably clean and free from rubbish, weeds, fungoid growths and long
grass.
(2) Every such owner or occupier shall during the first week of the months of March, June, September and December in each and every year, execute such work as aforesaid.

83 Keeping public places tidy and safe

(1) No person shall deposit or throw on any public place –
(a) Rubbish of any kind;
(b) Glass or any other substance or matter likely to damage the tyres of
any vehicle.
(2) If any slippery substance or any piercing substance or glass falls from
any vehicle upon any public place, it shall be the duty of the driver of any vehicle
involved to remove or cause to be removed immediately that substance from the
public place.
PART 11
BICYCLES

84 Bicycles to comply with special requirements

Without limiting in any way the provisions of this Act relating to vehicles,
sections 85-94 shall apply with respect to bicycles.

85 Headlamps

No person shall ride a bicycle in any public place during the hours of
darkness unless it has attached at the front a lamp displaying a light substantially
white in colour of sufficient brilliance to be visible under normal atmospheric
conditions for at least 300 feet in a forward direction.

86 Rear reflectors

No person shall ride a bicycle in any public place –
(a) Unless it is fitted with an approved red reflector in a clean and
efficient condition or approved reflecting red tape not less than 8
square inches in area placed at the back of the bicycle so as to reflect
directly to the rear light shining towards it from the rearward of
the bicycle; or

Transport Act 1965 1639

(b) Unless it displays at the rear a white surface of at least 12 square inches (inclusive of the area taken up by an approved reflector) or approved reflecting red tape not less than 8 square inches in area maintained in a clean condition at a place where the surface or tape is not likely to be obscured by the rider or his clothes.

87 Prohibited lights

No person shall ride a bicycle in any public place if it is equipped with a
lamp that displays towards the rear any light other than a red light or with a lamp
or reflecting surface that displays towards the front any red or reddish light.

88 Brakes

No person shall ride a bicycle in any public place unless it is fitted with at
least one efficient brake which operates on the rear wheel.

89 Special equipment if infants are taken for a ride

No person shall ride a bicycle in any public place –
(a) Fitted with a pillion seat, unless adequate foot rests are fitted for
any infant carried on the pillion seat; or
(b) Fitted with any other seat or a container for the carriage of an infant,
unless the legs of the infant are adequately protected by guards
from coming into contact with the wheels of the bicycle.

90 Riding prohibited on footpaths and over cultivated land

No person shall ride a bicycle on any footpath or footway or on any lawn,
garden, or other cultivation forming part of a public place.

91 Towing prohibited

No person riding a bicycle in any public place shall permit the bicycle to be
towed by any other vehicle.

92 Warning signal before right-hand turn

Every person riding a bicycle when about to turn to his right in view of
other traffic shall before doing so give reasonable notice of his intention by
extending his full arm horizontally to the right.

93 Riding in batches restricted

Except when heavy traffic conditions make it unreasonable to do otherwise,
no person shall ride a bicycle so that –
(a) More than 2 bicycles remain abreast; or
(b) Two bicycles remain abreast while overtaking and passing any other
vehicle.

94 Dangerous riding

Every person commits an offence who rides a bicycle in any public place
recklessly or negligently or at a speed or in a manner which is dangerous to any
other person, having regard to the nature, condition, and use of the public place
and all other circumstances of the case.
1640 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
PART 12
PASSENGER SERVICES

95 No liquor on public transport

(1) No person shall consume or attempt to consume or cause any other
person to consume intoxicating liquor in or on any omnibus or vehicle serving for
the time being as an omnibus, taxicab or any other vehicles for the time being
designed, used, kept, or being available for the carriage for hire or reward of
members of the public.
(2) In this section “intoxicating liquor” has the same meaning as in the
Liquor Act 1975.

96 Speed limit for trucks carrying passengers

Notwithstanding anything in this Act no person shall drive a truck carrying
passengers, whether for hire or reward or otherwise, under any circumstances (be
it within the boundaries of any village or any area declared to be subject to speed
limits or outside such boundaries or areas) at a greater speed than 25 miles per
hour.
PART 13
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

98 Approval of equipment for a transition period and exemptions from

equipment requirements

(1) Cabinet may, by notice published as it directs and for any period of
time as it thinks fit –
(a) Approve of any equipment or type of equipment for use under this
Act and the use of any equipment so approved or of a type so
approved shall, while it is maintained in good working order and
any conditions of the approval are complied with, be deemed to be
a sufficient compliance with this Act;
(b) Grant exemption in respect of any specified class of vehicle from
any of the requirements relating to equipment prescribed by this
Act, subject to such conditions as it thinks fit to impose.
(2) Any approval so given and any exemption so granted may be at any
time withdrawn by Cabinet by notice as aforesaid.

99 Compensation for conversion

(1) (a) If any person is convicted of the offence of converting any vehicle
or part of it under section 188 of the Niue Act 1966, the court may
order the person so convicted to pay to the owner of the vehicle
destroyed or damaged, by way of compensation for the destruction
or damage, a sum not exceeding the amount of loss suffered by
him.
(b) The making or enforcement of an order as aforesaid shall not affect
the right of the owner or any other person to recover by civil
proceedings any damages in excess of the sum recovered under
the order.
(2) Any order for payment under this section may be enforced in the same
manner as a fine.

Transport Act 1965 1641

100 Unlawful interference with vehicle

Every person commits an offence and shall be liable to imprisonment for a
term not exceeding 3 months or a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units who unlawfully
and without colour of right interferes with or gets into or upon or attempts to get
into or upon any vehicle.

101 Power of Police

Every constable in uniform may –
(a) Direct the driver of any vehicle to stop his vehicle;
(b) Inspect, test and examine the brakes or any other part of any vehicle
or equipment of it;
(c) Move or cause to be moved to any place of safety at the expense of
the owner any vehicle if in the opinion of the constable it causes an
obstruction in any public place or has some mechanical defect likely
to impair its safe use in a public place or its removal is necessary
for any other reason;
(d) Generally take all steps necessary for the control of traffic in any
public place under this Act.

102 Offences

Every person commits an offence who –
(a) Fails to comply with a direction given under this Act by a constable,
the Registrar, the Testing Authority, or any other person authorised
to give directions under this Act;
(b) Wilfully obstructs any person in the execution of any duty imposed
on that person by this Act;
(c) Fails to comply with any condition, duty, or obligation imposed on
him by this Act;
(d) Does or omits, or causes or knowingly permits or suffers to be done
or omitted, any act, matter, or thing contrary to this Act;
(e) Offends against or fails to comply with this Act;
(f) Knowingly makes a substantially false statement in any application
or notice under this Act or in connection with any information which
he is required to furnish under this Act.

103 General penalties

Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no penalty
is provided in this Act elsewhere than in this section or in the Niue Act 1966 is
liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

104 Act to bind the Crown

Except as provided in this Act, this Act shall bind the Crown.

105 [Spent]

106 Application of fees and fines

All fees, fines and other moneys received under this Act shall form part of
the public revenues of Niue and shall be paid into the appropriate account.

1642 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

107 Regulations

Cabinet may make all such regulations -

(a) As may seem necessary or expedient for giving full effect to this

Act and for its due administration;

(b) Prescribing fines, not exceeding 2 penalty units, for the breach of any regulations made under this Act.

Transport Act 1965 1643

Section 7

SCHEDULE

Form No. 1

Transport Act 1965

FORM OF APPLICATION FOR REGISTRATION OF MOTOR VEHICLE

To the Registrar of Motor Vehicles:

I apply for registration of the motor vehicle particulars of which are given below: Name of Owner:

Address:

Class of motor vehicle:

Make of motor vehicle:

Engine No.:

Chassis No.:

Seating Accommodation: * persons

Intended for –

Private use; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire; or

Conveyance of goods; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire and goods

Gross weight of motor vehicle unladen: ** lbs

Manufacturer ’s rating of weight carrying capacity: lbs

Dated this day of 20 .

................................................................................................................... (Signature of owner)

*Not required for motor or power cycles

**Not required for motor cycle, power cycle or private motor cars

1644 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Section 9

Form No 2

Transport Act 1965

CERTIFICATE OF REGISTRATION OF MOTOR VEHICLE

This is to certify that the motor vehicle, particulars of which are given below, has been registered under the above Act

Name of Owner: Address:

Class of motor vehicle: Make of motor vehicle: Engine No.:

Chassis No.:

Description of Motor Vehicle

Seating Accommodation: * persons

Intended for –

Private use; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire; or

Conveyance of goods; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire and goods

Gross weight of motor vehicle unladen: lbs

Manufacturer ’s rating of weight carrying capacity: lbs

Registration No:

(a) Number of persons, excluding the driver, which the vehicle may lawfully

carry at any one time;

(b) Maximum weight of goods, or passengers, or both, which the vehicle

may lawfully carry.

Dated this this day of 20 .

........................................................................................................ Registrar of Motor Vehicles

Transport Act 1965 1645

Section 14

Form No 3

Transport Act 1965

FORM OF APPLICATION FOR ANNUAL LICENCE TO USE MOTOR VEHICLE

To the Registrar of Motor Vehicles:

I apply for a licence to use the motor vehicle particulars of which are given below:

Name of Owner:

Address:

Class of motor vehicle:

Make of motor vehicle:

Engine No:

Chassis No:

Seating Accommodation: *

persons

Intended for –

Private use; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire; or

Conveyance of goods; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire and goods

Gross weight of motor vehicle unladen:

**

lbs

Manufacturer ’s rating of weight carrying capacity:

lbs

Registration No.

Dated at

this

day of

20

.

................................................................................................................... (Signature of owner)

*Not required for motor or power cycles

**Not required for motor cycles, power cycles or private motor cars

1646 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Section 16

Form No 4

Transport Act 1965

ANNUAL LICENCE TO USE MOTOR VEHICLE

The motor vehicle, particulars of which are set out hereunder, may, in accordance with the above Act, be used on any road on Niue while this licence continues in force.

Name of Owner: Address:

Class of motor vehicle: Make of motor vehicle: Engine No:

Chassis No:

Description of Motor Vehicle

Seating Accommodation: persons

Intended for –

Private use; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire; or

Conveyance of goods; or

Conveyance of passengers for hire and goods

Gross weight of motor vehicle unladen: lbs

Manufacturer ’s rating of weight carrying capacity: lbs

Registration No:

If trade motor –

(a) Number of persons, excluding the driver, which the vehicle may lawfully

carry at any one time;

(b) Maximum weight of goods, or passengers, or both, which the vehicle

may lawfully carry.

Subject to the provisions of the Transport Act, this licence shall continue in force until 31

March 20 .

Dated at this day of 20 .

........................................................................................................ Registrar of Motor Vehicles

Transport Act 1965 1647

Section 20

Form No. 5

Transport Act

APPLICATION FOR A MOTOR DRIVERS LICENCE

To the Registrar of Motor Vehicles:

I apply for the issue to me of a motor driver ’s licence under the Transport Act in respect of a motor vehicle of the following class (classes):

And I declare that to the best of my knowledge and belief the particulars here set forth are true and correct.

Full name of applicant: Place of residence: Occupation:

Class or classes of motor vehicles in respect of which a driver ’s licence is applied for: Is applicant above the age of 16 years?

If applicant has been the holder of any licence to drive a motor vehicle give particulars as to –

Name of authority by whom licence issued:

Date of issue:

Remarks:

Has applicant ever been refused a motor driver ’s licence?

If so, give particulars:

Has applicant ever been convicted of any offence arising out of the driving of any motor

vehicle?

What is applicant’s experience of motor driving?

Dated at this day of 20 .

................................................................................................................ Signature of Applicant

1648 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Section 22

Form No. 6

Transport Act MOTOR DRIVERS LICENCE No

To be produced on demand

Name of Licensee: m/f Date of birth: Address:

Occupation:

This licence applies only to (insert class or classes of motor vehicle)

This licence expires on the day of 20.

Date of issue:

Signature of Registrar:

Signature of Licensee:

Transport Act 1965 1649

Section 70

Form No. 7

Transport Act 1965

WARRANT OF FITNESS

To be retained by Testing Authority

No. Make:

Regd No.:

Speedometer Reading:

Name of Owner: Address:

Date of examination: / /

........................................................................................................................................................

Signature of Testing Authority

To be issued to Owner

(Front)

Warrant of Fitness No. (Month of issue in letters) (Month of expiry in figures)

(Back) No.:

Issued by:

Regd No. and Make:

........................................................................................................................................................ Expiry date: ........................ / ........... / .........

1650 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1651

TRUSTEE ACT 1956

1956/61 (NZ) – 1 January 1957

1 Short title

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

Indemnities

34 Protection against liability in respect of

rents and covenants

34A Lien on policy money for premiums

2 Interpretation and application

3 Act to bind Crown

PART 2

INVESTMENTS

4 Power to invest

5-13 [Repealed]

PART 3

GENERAL POWERS AND INDEMNITIES OF TRUSTEES

General Powers

14 Powers to sell, exchange, partition,

postpone, lease, purchase

15 Miscellaneous powers

16 Power of trustee for sale to sell

17 Power to sell property on terms

18 Sale subject to depreciatory conditions

19 Power of trustees to give receipts

20 Power to compound liabilities

21 Power to raise money by sale or mortgage

22 Protection of purchasers

23 Devolution of powers or trusts

24 Power to insure

25 Application of insurance money where

policy kept up under any trust, power or

obligation

26 Deposit of documents for safe custody

27 Reversionary interests

28 Valuations

29 Power to employ agents

30 Power to concur with others

31 Power to delegate trusts

32 Power to carry on business

33 Power to convert business into a company

33A Trustee may sue himself in a different

capacity

35 Protection against creditors

36 Protection in regard to notice

37 Exoneration of trustees in respect of certain

powers of attorney

38 Implied indemnity of trustees

39 Protection of trustee who pays trust money

to bankrupt

39A Protection of trustee in handing over

chattels to life tenant

39B Protection of trustee in handing over

chattels to infant

Maintenance, Advancement and Protective Trusts

40 Power to apply income for maintenance

41 Power to apply capital for maintenance

41A Conditional advances for maintenance

42 Protective trusts

PART 4

APPOINTMENT AND DISCHARGE OF TRUSTEES

43 Power of appointing new trustees

44 Evidence as to a vacancy in a trust

45 Retirement of trustee

46 Discharge of trustee

47 Vesting of trust property in new or

continuing trustees

48 Corporations acting as trustees

49 Advisory trustees

50 Custodian trustees

PART 5

POWERS OF THE COURT

Appointment of New Trustees

51 Power of Court to appoint new trustees

Vesting Orders

52 Vesting orders of land

1652 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

53 Contingent rights of unborn persons

54 Vesting order in place of conveyance by

infant mortgagee

55 Vesting order consequential on order for

sale or mortgage of land

56 Vesting order consequential on judgment

for specific performance

57 Effect of vesting order

58 Power to appoint person to convey

59 Vesting orders as to stock and things in

action

60 Vesting orders in respect of shares in ships

and industrial property

61 Vesting orders of charity property

62 Orders made upon certain allegations to be

conclusive evidence

63 [Repealed]

Jurisdictions to Make Other Orders

64 Power of Court to authorise dealings with

trust property and variations of trust

64A Powers of Court to authorise variations

65 [Repealed]

66 Right of trustee to apply to Court for

directions

67 Persons entitled to apply to Court

68 Applications to Court to review acts and

decisions of trustee

69 Protection of trustee while acting under

direction of Court

70 Powers of Court to give judgment in

absence of a trustee

71 Power of Court to charge costs

72 Commission

73 Power to relieve trustee from personal

liability

74 Power to make beneficiary indemnify for breach of trust

75 Barring of claims

76 Distribution of shares of missing

beneficiaries

76A Service of notices under sections 75 and 76

Payment to Crown

77 Payment by trustees to Crown

78 Disposal of funds paid to Crown

79 Orders in respect of funds paid to Crown

PART 6

GENERAL PROVISIONS

80 Indemnity to banks and others

81 Operation on bank account of trustees

82 [Repealed]

83 Special rules as to apportionment

83A Examination of accounts of trust estates

administered by trustee corporations

83B Audit of other trust estates

84 Costs and testamentary expenses to be

payable out of capital of settled residuary

estate of deceased

85 Application of income of settled property

pending conversion

86 Fees and commission deemed a

testamentary expense

87 Costs of inquiring regarding beneficiaries

88 Life tenant to have powers of a trustee in

certain cases

89 [Spent]

90 Regulations

To consolidate and amend the law relating to trusts and trustees

1 Short title

This is the Trustee Act 1956.
PART 1
PRELIMINARY

2 Interpretation and application

(1) In this Act –
“authorised investments” means investments authorised for the investment
of money subject to the trust by the instrument, if any, creating the
trust or by this Act or any other Act;
“Bank” means a bank licensed under the Banking Act 1986;
“benefit”, in relation to any person, includes insurance on the life of that
person;
“contingent right” as applied to land includes a contingent or executory
interest, a possibility coupled with an interest, whether the object of

Trustee Act 1956 1653

the gift or limitations of the interest or possibility is or is not ascertained, also a right of entry, whether immediate or future, and whether vested or contingent;
“conveyance”, as applied to any person, includes the execution by that person of every necessary or suitable assurance for conveying, transferring, assigning, appointment, surrendering, or otherwise disposing of land whereof he is seized or possessed, or wherein he is entitled to a contingent right, either for his whole estate, or for any less estate, together with the performance of all formalities required by law for the validity of the conveyance;
“income” includes rents and profits other than profits which under any rule of law are in the nature of capital;
“instrument” includes an Act;
“land” includes land of any tenure, and mines and minerals, whether or
not severed from the surface, buildings or parts of buildings, whether
the division is horizontal, vertical, or made in any other way, and any
other corporeal hereditament; and also includes a rent and other
incorporeal hereditaments, and an easement, right, privilege, share,
interest, or benefit in, over, or derived from land; and in this definition
“mines and minerals” includes any strata or seams of minerals or
substances in or under any land, and powers of working and getting
the same; and in this definition “hereditaments” means real property
which under an intestacy might at common law have devolved on an
heir;
“lease” includes a bailment;
“mortgagee” includes every person having an estate or interest regarded
at law or in equity as merely a security for money; and also includes
every person deriving title to the mortgage under the original
mortgagee;
“payment”, in relation to stocks and securities, includes the deposit or
transfer of the same;
“personal representative” means the executor, original or by representation,
or an administrator for the time being of a deceased person;
“possession” includes receipt of income or the right to receive the same, if
any; and “possessed” applies to receipt of income of and to any vested
estate less than a life interest, at law or in equity, in possession or in
expectancy in any land;
“property” includes real and personal property, and any estate, share, and
interest in any property, real or personal, and any debt, and any thing
in action, and any other right or interest, whether in possession or not;
“registrar” means the Registrar of the Court for the district in which any
proceeding is taken or anything is done under this Act, and includes a
Deputy Registrar where there is no Registrar, or in any case where the
Deputy may lawfully act for and on behalf of the Registrar;
“rent” includes a rent service or a rentcharge, or other rent, toll, duty, royalty,
or annual or periodical payment in money or money’s worth reserved
or issuing out of or charged upon land, but does not include mortgage
interest;
“right” includes an estate or interest;
“sale” includes an exchange;
“securities” includes stock, funds, and shares; and “securities payable to
bearer” includes securities transferable by delivery or by delivery and
endorsement;
1654 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“stock” includes Government securities, and shares; and, so far as relates to vesting orders made by the Court under this Act, includes any fund, money, annuity, or security transferable in books kept by any corporation or society, or by instrument of transfer either alone or accompanied by other formalities, and any share or interest in it;
“transfer”, in relation to stock or securities, includes the performance and
execution of every deed, power of attorney, act, and thing on the part
of the transferor to effect and complete the title in the transferee;
“trust” does not include the duties incidental to an estate conveyed by
way of mortgage, but with this exception it extends to implied and
constructive trusts, and to cases where the trustee has a beneficial
interest in the trust property, and to the duties incidental to the office of
an administrator within the meaning of the Administration Act 1952;
“trust for sale”, in relation to land, means an immediate binding trust for
sale, whether or not exercisable at the request or with the consent of
any person, and with or without power at discretion to postpone the
sale;
“trustee for sale” means the person (including a personal representative)
holding land on trust for sale.
(2) For the purposes of this Act a person shall be deemed to be under a
disability while he is not of full age or full mental capacity.
(3) This Act, except where otherwise expressly provided, applies to trusts
constituted or created either before or after the commencement of this Act.
(4) The powers conferred by or under this Act on a trustee who is not a
corporation are in addition to the powers given by any other Act and by the
instrument, if any, creating the trust; but the powers conferred on the trustee by
this Act, unless otherwise stated, apply if and so far only as a contrary intention is
not expressed in the instrument, if any, creating the trust, and have effect subject
to the terms of that instrument.
(5) The powers conferred by or under this Act on a trustee that is a
corporation are in addition to the powers given by the instrument, if any, creating
the trust and to the powers given by or under the Act or any instrument by or
under which the corporation is constituted and any other Act; but the powers
conferred on the trustee by this Act, unless otherwise stated –
(a) Apply if and so far only as a contrary intention is not expressed in
the instrument, if any, creating the trust, and have effect subject to
the terms of that instrument;
(b) (i) Apply if and so far only as a contrary intention is not expressed
in the Act or any instrument by or under which the corporation
is constituted and any other Act and have effect subject to the
terms of every such Act and instrument;
(ii) Nothing in this paragraph shall affect any Act which applies to
all trustees, whether corporations or not.

3 Act to bind Crown

This Act shall bind the Crown.

Trustee Act 1956 1655

4 Power to invest

PART 2
INVESTMENTS
(1) A trustee may invest any trust funds, whether at the time in a state of investment or not, in any property.
(2) Subject to subsections (3) and (4), a trustee exercising any power of
investment shall exercise the care, diligence, and skill that a prudent person of
business would exercise in managing the affairs of others.
(3) Subject to subsection (4), where a trustee’s profession, employment, or
business is or includes acting as a trustee or investing money on behalf of others,
the trustee, in exercising any power of investment, shall exercise the care, diligence,
and skill that a prudent person engaged in that profession, employment, or business
would exercise in managing the affairs of others.
(4) The duty imposed on a trustee by subsection (2) or (3) shall apply to a
trustee if and so far only as a contrary intention is not expressed in the instrument,
if any, creating the trust or any Act, and shall have effect subject to the terms of
that instrument or Act.

5-13 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 3
GENERAL POWERS AND INDEMNITIES OF TRUSTEES

General Powers

14 Powers to sell, exchange, partition, postpone, lease, purchase

(1) Subject to this section, every trustee may exercise the following powers
in respect of any property for the time being vested in him –
(a) Sell the property;
(b) Dispose of the property by way of exchange for other property in
Niue of a like nature and a like or better tenure, or, where the
property vested in him consists of an undivided share, concur in
the partition of the property in which the share is held, and give or
take any property by way of equality of exchange or partition;
(c) Postpone the sale, calling in, and conversion of the property, whether
or not it is of a wasting, speculative or reversionary nature:
Provided that nothing in this paragraph shall permit a trustee to
postpone the sale, calling in, or conversion of any property of a
wasting or speculative nature for longer than is reasonably
necessary to permit its prudent realisation;
(d) Let or sublet the property at a reasonable rent for any term not
exceeding one year, or from year to year, or for a weekly, monthly,
or other like tenancy, or at will;
(e) Grant a lease or sublease of the property for any term not exceeding
21 years to take effect in possession within one year next after the
date of the grant of the lease or sublease at a reasonable rent, with
or without a fine, premium or foregift:
Provided that where a fine, premium or foregift is taken, the amount
of it shall be deemed to be part of and an accretion to the rental,
and shall, as between the persons beneficially entitled to the rental,
be considered as accruing from day to day and be apportioned over
the term of the lease or sublease;
(f) At any time during the currency of a lease of the property, reduce
the rent or otherwise vary or modify the terms of it;
1656 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(g) In the case of property subject to a lease, grant to a sublessee (with the consent of the lessee) a lease direct from the trustee of the whole or any part of the land comprised in the original lease for the residue of the original term.
(2) Any trustee may purchase land in Niue in any of the following cases – (a) If the land being purchased adjoins other land which the trustee has power to retain and which is held by the trustee on the same trusts as the money expended in respect of the purchase of the land,
and the amount so expended does not exceed $2000;
(b) If the land being purchased has a dwellinghouse on it and is required
exclusively or principally as a home for the person entitled to the
income of the money being expended in respect of the purchase.
(2A) Any trustee may erect a dwellinghouse on land that is subject to the
same trusts as the money being expended in respect of the erection, or may
purchase land in Niue and erect a dwellinghouse on it, if the dwellinghouse and
land are required exclusively or principally as a home for the person entitled to
the income of the money being expended in respect of the erection or the purchase
and erection, as the case may be.
(2B) In any case where a trustee is authorised by or under this Act or any
other enactment, or by the instrument creating the trust, to provide or acquire a
home for any person, he shall have power, in addition to any authority so
conferred –
(a) To acquire a flat or apartment or the right to occupy a flat or
apartment by any means which he may consider appropriate
(whether by acquiring shares in a limited liability company or an
undivided share or interest in the land on which the premises are
erected or in any other way); and
(b) To enter into any lease, licence, agreement, or other arrangement
under which he or his nominee or the beneficiary who is to occupy
the flat or apartment has the right to occupy it (including an
arrangement whereby any shares in a limited liability company and
the benefit of any such lease, licence, or agreement may be held by
that beneficiary or by some other nominee or the trustee upon trust
for him).
(3) Any trustee may accept or concur or join with any other person in
accepting a lease or sublease of any property on such terms and subject to such
covenants and conditions as he thinks fit; and may surrender or concur or join
with any other person in surrendering any lease or sublease; and, if lessor or
sublessor, may accept or concur or join in with any other person in the acceptance
of the surrender of any lease or sublease.
(4) Any trustee may, on such conditions as he thinks proper, rescind or
cancel or modify or vary any contract or agreement for the sale and purchase of
any land, or agree to do so, or compromise with or make allowances to any person
with whom such contract or agreement has been made, or who is the assignee of
it in respect of any unpaid purchase money secured on mortgage or otherwise.
(5) In exercising any power of leasing or subleasing conferred by this section
or by the instrument (if any) creating the trust, a trustee may –
(a) Grant to the lessee or sublessee a right of renewal for one or more
terms at a rent to be fixed or made ascertainable in a manner
specified in the original lease or the original sublease, but so that
the aggregate duration of the original and of the renewed terms
shall not exceed the maximum single term that could be granted in
exercise of the power;

Trustee Act 1956 1657

(b) Subject to this section, grant a lease with an optional or compulsory purchasing clause:
Provided that this power shall not apply to the exercise of any power of sale conferred by any mortgage unless the mortgage confers authority to do so;
(c) Grant to the lessee or sublessee a right to claim compensation for
improvements made or to be made by him in, upon, or about the
property which is leased or subleased.
(6) (a) No trustee shall, without the consent of the Court, exercise any
power conferred on him by this section of granting a lease with an
optional or compulsory purchasing clause, or of selling or
exchanging any freehold and, in any case where the value of land
(as determined under section 28) exceeds $15,000.
(b) A trustee may, without the consent of the Court, sell any such land
for more than $15,000 in exercise of the powers conferred on him
by this section, if (under section 28) he has in good faith fixed the
value of the land immediately before the sale at $15,000 or less.
(6A) Where a person dies intestate as to any personal chattels within the
meaning of the Administration Act 1969 and leaves a husband or wife, the trustee
of his estate shall not, without the consent of the Court or of the husband or wife,
sell those chattels, unless a sale is required for purposes of administration owing
to want of other assets.
(6B) Where upon inquiry the Court is satisfied that a partition of the real
estate of a deceased person would be advantageous to the parties interested in it,
the Court may order a partition or may appoint one or more arbitrators to effect a
partition, and to exercise in regard to it, under its directions and control, such
powers as it thinks fit; and if the report and final award of the arbitrator are
approved by the Court, the trustee shall, by conveyance or transfer, give effect to
the same accordingly.
(7) (a) Where there is a power (statutory or otherwise) to postpone the
sale of any land or authorised investment that a trustee has a duty
to sell by reason only of a trust or direction for sale, then (subject to
any express direction to the contrary in the instrument, if any,
creating the trust), the trustee shall not be liable in any way merely
for postponing the sale, in the exercise of his discretion, for an
indefinite and unlimited period, whether or not that period exceeds
the period during which the trust or direction for sale remains valid;
nor shall a purchaser of the land or authorised investment be
concerned in any case with any directions respecting the
postponement of a sale;
(b) This subsection shall not apply to any property of a wasting or
speculative nature.

15 Miscellaneous powers

(1) Every trustee may exercise the following powers in respect of any
property for the time being vested in him –
(a) Expend money subject to the same trusts for the repair, maintenance,
upkeep, or renovation of the property, whether or not the work is
necessary for the purpose of the salvage of the property; and (subject
to the rules of law applicable in such cases and to any direction of
the court to the contrary) apportion the cost of the work between
capital and income or otherwise among the persons entitled thereto
1658 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
in such manner as he considers equitable, with power, in any case where the whole or part of the cost of the work is charged to capital, to recoup capital from subsequent income if such a course would be equitable having regard to all the circumstances of the case;
(b) Expend money subject to the same trusts in the improvement or development of the property or in improving his title to the property or his tenure thereof, whether by the acquisition of an interest in reversion or otherwise:
Provided that, in exercise of the power conferred by this paragraph,
not more than $10,000 may be so expended by a trustee without the
consent of the Court for any one purpose.
(c) Where the property is land and the land may be sold or let or leased
or otherwise disposed of under any power or trust vested in the
trustee, subdivide the land into sections and for that purpose
construct and dedicate all such roads, streets, access ways, service
lanes, and footpaths and make all such reserves, and do all such
other things, and pay all such money, as he thinks necessary or as
are required by any law or bylaw relating to subdivisions;
(d) Contribute out of money subject to the same trusts such sum as he
thinks reasonable towards the construction and maintenance of such
roads, streets, access ways, service lanes, and footpaths, and such
sewerage, water, electricity, drainage and other works as are in the
opinion of the trustee likely to be beneficial to the property,
notwithstanding that they are intended to be constructed wholly
or in part on land not subject to the same trusts;
(e) Grant easements and profits à prendre and enter into party wall
agreements and agreements which relate to fencing and execute all
necessary documents to give effect to it;
(f) Pay rates, taxes, assessments, insurance premiums, and other
outgoings in respect of the property out of money subject to the
same trusts;
(g) As mortgage or mortgagee, agree to the renewal, extension, or
variation of the mortgage for such period and on such terms and
conditions as he thinks fit:
Provided that the powers conferred by this paragraph may be
exercised by a trustee as mortgagor for the purpose of raising
additional money on the security of a mortgage of any property in
any case where the trustee would have power under section 21 to
raise money by a mortgage of the property, but not otherwise:
Provided also that nothing in this paragraph shall authorise any
trustee to advance any money on the security of any mortgage that
would not be an authorised investment in respect of the amount
advanced;
(h) Make such inquiries, by way of advertisement or otherwise, as he
deems necessary for the purposes of ascertaining the next-of-kin or
beneficiaries entitled to the property, and charge the cost of the
inquiries and advertisements against the property;
(i) Where the property includes a life policy and there is no money or
insufficient money available for the payment of premiums on the
policy, surrender the policy for money, or accept instead of the policy
a fully paid up policy, or vary the terms of the policy in such manner
as the trustee thinks fit;

Trustee Act 1956 1659

(j) Appropriate any part of the property in or towards satisfaction of any legacy payable or any share (whether settled, contingent or absolute) to which any person is entitled, and for that purpose value the whole or any part of the property under section 28 of this Act: Provided that before any such appropriation is effectual notice thereof shall be given to all persons of full age and full mental capacity who are interested in the appropriation, and any such person may within one calendar month after receipt of the notice apply to the Court to vary the same, and the appropriation shall be conclusive save as otherwise directed by the Court:
Provided also that where the person interested is out of the jurisdiction the said period of one month may be extended by the court for such period as the Court thinks fit, on the application of the trustee or of any person interested;
(k) Where provision is made in any instrument creating a trust for
payment of annuity or other periodical payment, and
notwithstanding that the annuity or payment may by the instrument
be charged upon the trust property or upon any part of it, set aside
and appropriate out of property available for payment of the annuity
and invest a sum sufficient in the opinion of the trustee at the time
of the appropriation to provide out of the income of it the amount
required to pay the annuity or periodical payment, and, after the
appropriation shall have been made, the residue of the trust
property and the income of it shall no longer be liable for the annuity,
and may be distributed forthwith under the trusts declared of and
concerning the same;
(l) Do or omit all acts and things and execute all instruments necessary
to carry into effect the powers and authorities given by this Act or
by or under the instrument creating the trust.
(2) (a) Where in the administration of any property employed in the
production of income or from which income is derived a trustee
considers that in the interests of the persons entitled or who may
become entitled to the capital of the property it is equitable to set
up a depreciation or replacement fund in respect of the property or
in respect of any asset comprised in it, then, notwithstanding any
rule of law to the contrary, it shall be lawful for but not obligatory
upon him to do so, and to credit to the fund and accumulate by
way of compound interest such part of the income so produced or
derived as he considers equitable and also the resulting income
from it.
(b) In any such case the fund shall follow the destination of the capital
of the property and shall be subject to all the trusts, powers, and
provisions applicable to it; with further power to the trustee to apply
as he thinks fit the fund and accumulations of income in or towards
the replacement, repair or otherwise of property or assets of a like
nature or which otherwise may advantageously be employed in
conjunction with the property in producing or deriving the income
as aforesaid.
1660 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

16 Power of trustee for sale to sell

(1) Where a trust for sale or a power of sale of property is vested in a trustee,
he may sell or concur with any other person in selling all or any part of the property,
either subject to prior encumbrances or not, and either together or in lots, by public
auction or by public tender or by private contract, subject to any such conditions
respecting title or evidence of title or other matters as the trustee thinks fit, with
power to vary any contract for sale, and to buy in at any auction, or to rescind any
contract for sale and to resell, without being answerable for any loss.
(2) A trust or power to sell or dispose of land includes a trust or power to
sell or dispose of part of it; whether the division is horizontal, vertical, or made in
any other way; and also includes a trust or power to sell or dispose of any buildings,
fixtures, timbers, or other things affixed to the soil apart and separately from the
land itself.
(3) In exercise of any power of sale in respect of several properties held
under one lease, the trustee may sell the properties separately on the terms that
one of the purchasers shall take an assignment of the lease and grant subleases to
the other purchasers, and that if any part of the property is not sold the trustee
shall retain the lease and grant subleases of the portions sold.
(4) Where a trustee may sell any property at a fixed or specified time under
any trust or power vested in him, the trustee may, with the consent of the persons
(if any) entitled to sell the possession of it pending the sale of the property, sell the
property at any time before the date originally appointed.

17 Power to sell property on terms

(1) A sale of property by a trustee in exercise of any power vested in him
in that behalf by the instrument creating the trust or by or under this Act or any
other enactment may be on terms of deferred payment or otherwise.
(2) The terms of deferred payment shall be such as a person acting with
prudence would, if the property were his own, have accepted in the circumstances
in order to sell the property to the best advantage, and, subject to it, may provide
for the payment of the purchase money or any part thereof under an agreement
for sale or for the conveyance of the property sold and the securing of the unpaid
purchase money by mortgage of the property sold.
(3) Whether the sale is made under the order of the Court or otherwise,
the Court may make such order as it thinks fit as to the terms of deferred payment.
(4) A trustee selling property on terms authorised by this section or by an
order of the Court shall not be affected by section 4 or section 10 in respect of so
much of the purchase money as is payable under an agreement for sale or is secured
by a mortgage, and shall not be liable for any loss that may be incurred by reason
only of the security being insufficient at the date of the agreement or mortgage.
(5) For the purposes of any consent or direction required by the instrument,
if any, creating the trust or by statute, a trustee selling property on terms of deferred
payment shall not be deemed to be lending money or investing trust funds.

18 Sale subject to depreciatory conditions

(1) No sale made by a trustee shall be impeached by any beneficiary upon
the ground that any of the conditions subject to which the sale was made may
have been unnecessarily depreciatory, unless it also appears that the consideration
for the sale was thereby rendered inadequate.
(2) No sale made by a trustee shall, after the execution of the conveyance
or transfer, be impeached as against the purchaser upon the ground that any of
the conditions subject to which the sale was made may have been unnecessarily

Trustee Act 1956 1661

depreciatory, unless it appears that the purchaser was acting in collusion with the trustee at the time when the contract for sale was made.
(3) No purchaser, upon any sale made by a trustee, shall be at liberty to make any objection against the title upon any of the grounds aforesaid.

19 Power of trustees to give receipts

(1) The receipt in writing of a trustee for any money, securities, or other
personal property or effects payable, transferable, or deliverable to him under
any trust or power shall be a sufficient discharge to the person paying, transferring,
or delivering the same, and shall effectually exonerate that person from seeing
the application or being answerable for any loss or misapplication of it.
(2) This section applies notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the
instrument, if any, creating the trust.

20 Power to compound liabilities

A trustee may, if and as he thinks fit –
(a) Accept any property, real or personal, before the time at which it is
made transferable or payable; or
(b) Sever and apportion any blended trust funds or property; or
(c) Pay or allow any debt or claim on any evidence that he thinks
sufficient; or
(d) Accept any composition or any security, real or personal, for any
property, for any debt or for any property, real or personal, claimed;
or
(e) Allow any time for payment of any debt; or
(f) Surrender any leasehold property subject to onerous covenants of
such a nature that it would not be to the advantage of the person
beneficially interested to retain the property; or
(g) Compromise, compound, abandon, submit to arbitration, or
otherwise settle any debt, account, claim, or thing whatever relating
to the trust or to the trust property –
and for any of those purposes may enter into, give, execute, and do such
agreements, instruments of composition or arrangement, releases, and other things
as to him seem expedient, without being responsible for any loss occasioned by
any act or thing so done by him in good faith.

21 Power to raise money by sale or mortgage

(1) Where a trustee is authorised by the instrument, if any, creating the
trust or by this Act or any other Act or by law to pay or apply capital money
subject to the trust for any purpose or in any manner, he shall have and shall be
deemed always to have had power to raise the money required by sale, conversion,
calling in, or mortgage of all or any part of the trust property for the time being in
possession.
(2) Without restricting the generality of subsection (1), the power conferred
on the trustee by this section to raise any money that is required as aforesaid by
the sale, conversion, calling in, or mortgage of all or any part of the trust property
for the time being in possession shall extend and be deemed always to have
extended so as to confer on the trustee power so to raise money required for the
purpose of meeting any debt or other liability of the trustee, whether secured or
unsecured and whether owing or incurred at or before the commencement of the
trust or subsequently.
1662 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

22 Protection of purchasers

Where an instrument is made or executed in professed exercise of the power
to sell, exchange, lease, or mortgage conferred by the instrument (if any) creating
the trust or by this Act or any other Act, the title of the purchaser, transferee,
lessee, or mortgagee shall not be impeachable except on the ground of fraud, or
be affected on the ground that no case has arisen to authorise the sale, exchange,
lease, or mortgage, or that the power was otherwise improperly or irregularly
exercised; but any person damnified by an authorised or improper or irregular
exercise of the power shall have his remedy in damages against the person
exercising the power, and no purchaser, transferee, lessee, or mortgagee shall be
concerned to see to the application of the money paid by him, or be responsible
for the misapplication of it.

23 Devolution of powers or trusts

(1) Where a power or trust is given to or imposed on 2 or more trustees
jointly, the same may be exercised or performed by the survivors or survivor of
them for the time being.
(2) (a) Until the appointment of a new trustee, the personal representative
for the time being of a sole trustee or (where there were 2 or more
trustees) of the last surviving or continuing trustee shall be capable
of exercising or performing any power or trust which was given to,
or capable of being exercised by, the sole or last surviving or
continuing trustee, or other the trustees for the time being of the
trust;
(b) In this subsection “trustee” does not include a personal
representative as such.
(3) This section does not authorise the exercise or performance of any power
or trust by an executor who has renounced or has not proved.

24 Power to insure

(1) A trustee may insure against loss or damage, whether by fire or
earthquake or otherwise, any building or other insurable property to any amount,
including the amount of any insurance already on foot, not exceeding the full
insurable value of the building or property, or (with the consent of the person
entitled to the income of the Court) the full replacement value of the building or
property; and may also insure against any risk or liability against which it would
be prudent for a person to insure if he were acting for himself; and may pay the
premiums for the insurance out of the income of the building or property concerned
or out of the income of any other property subject to the same trusts without
obtaining the consent of any person who may be entitled wholly or partly to that
income.
(2) The trustee may recover the costs of any premiums paid in respect of
any such insurance from the life tenant or other person entitled to or in receipt of
the rents and profits of the building or property concerned.
(3) Nothing in this section shall impose any obligation on a trustee to insure.

25 Application of insurance money where policy kept up under any trust, power or obligation

(1) Money receivable by a trustee or any beneficiary under a policy of insurance against the loss of or damage to any property subject to a trust, whether by fire or otherwise, shall, where the policy has been kept up under any trust in that behalf or under any power, statutory or otherwise, or in performance of any

Trustee Act 1956 1663

covenant or of any obligation, statutory or otherwise, or by a tenant for life impeachable for waste, be capital for the purposes of the trust, except so far as it would be regarded as income under any rule of law.
(2) If any such money is receivable by any person other than the trustee of the trust, that person shall use his best endeavours to recover and receive the money, and shall pay the net residue of it, after discharging any costs of recovering and receiving it, to the trustee of the trust, or, if there is no trustee capable of giving a discharge for it, to the Crown under section 77.
(3) Any such money
(a) If it was receivable in respect of property held upon trust for sale,
shall be held upon the trusts and subject to the powers and
provisions applicable to money arising by a sale under the trust;
(b) In any other case, shall be held upon trust corresponding as nearly
as may be with the trusts affecting the property in respect of which
it was payable.
(4) Any such money, or any part thereof, may also be applied by the trustee,
or, if held by the Crown, under the direction of the Court, in rebuilding, reinstating,
replacing, or repairing the property lost or damaged, but any such application by
the trustee shall be subject to the consent of any person whose consent is required
by the instrument, if any, creating the trust to the investment of money subject to
the trust.
(5) Nothing in this section shall prejudice or affect the right of any person
to require any such money or any part thereof to be applied in rebuilding,
reinstating, or repairing the property lost or damaged, or the rights of any
mortgagee, lessor, or lessee, whether under any statute or otherwise.
(6) This section applies to policies effected either before or after the
commencement of this Act, but only to money received after the commencement.

26 Deposit of documents for safe custody

A trustee may deposit any documents held by him relating to the trust, or
to the trust property, with any bank or corporation whose business includes the
undertaking of the safe custody of documents, and any sum payable in respect of
any such deposit shall be paid out of the income of the trust property, and so far as
there is no available income out of the capital of the trust property.

27 Reversionary interests

(1) Where trust property includes any share or interest in property not
vested in the trustee, or the proceeds of the sale of any such property, or any other
thing in action, the trustee, on the same falling into possession or becoming payable
or transferable, may –
(a) Agree or ascertain the amount or value of it or any part of it in such
manner as he may think fit;
(b) Accept in or towards satisfaction of it, at the market or current value,
or upon any valuation or estimate of value which he may think fit,
any authorised investments;
(c) Allow any deductions for duties, costs, charges, and expenses which
he may think proper or reasonable;
(d) Execute any release in respect of the premises so as effectually to
discharge all accountable parties from all liability in respect of any
matters coming within the scope of the release –
without being responsible in any such case for any loss occasioned by any act or
thing so done by him in good faith.
1664 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) The trustee shall not be under any obligation and shall not be chargeable with any breach of trust by reason of any omission –
(a) To give any notice in respect of or apply for any charging or other like order upon any securities or other property out of or in which such share or interest or other thing in action as aforesaid is derived, payable, or charged; or
(b) To take any proceedings on account of any act, default, or neglect on the part of the persons in whom the securities or other property or any of them or any part of it are for the time being, or had at any time been, vested –
unless and until required in writing so to do by some person, or the guardian of some person, beneficially interested under the trust, and unless also due provision is made to his satisfaction for payment of the costs of any proceedings required to be taken.
(3) Nothing in subsection (2) shall relieve the trustee of the obligation to
get in and obtain payment or transfer of the share or interest or other thing in
action on the same falling into possession.

28 Valuations

(1) A trustee may, for the purpose of giving effect to the trust, or any of the
provisions of the instrument, if any, creating the trust or of this Act or any other
Act, ascertain and fix the value of any trust property, or of any property which he
is authorised to purchase or otherwise acquire, in such manner as he thinks proper;
and where the trustee is not personally qualified to ascertain the value of any
property he shall consult a duly qualified person (whether employed by him or
not) as to that value; but the trustee shall not be bound to accept any valuation
made by any person whom the trustee may consult.
(2) Any valuation made by the trustee in good faith under this section
shall be binding on all persons beneficially interested under the trust.

29 Power to employ agents

(1) A trustee may, instead of acting personally, employ and pay an agent,
whether a solicitor, accountant, bank, trustee corporation, stockbroker, or other
person, to transact any business or do any act required to be transacted or done in
the execution of the trust or the administration of the trust property, including the
receipt and payment of money, and the keeping and audit of trust accounts, and
shall be entitled to be allowed and paid all charges and expenses so incurred, and
shall not be responsible for the default of any such agent if employed in good
faith.
(2) A trustee may appoint any person to act as his agent or attorney for the purpose of selling, converting, collecting, getting in, and executing and perfecting assurances of, or managing or cultivating, or otherwise administering any property, real or personal, movable or immovable, subject to the trust in any place outside Niue or executing or exercising any discretion or trust or power vested in him in relation to any such property, with such ancillary powers and with and subject to such provisions and restrictions as he may think fit, including a power to appoint substitutes, and shall not, by reason only of his having made any such appointment, be responsible for any loss arising thereby;
(2A) Without restricting the other powers conferred by this section, a trustee may –
(a) Employ a trustee corporation to be his agent for the purpose of investing any trust funds in his possession, whether at the

Trustee Act 1956 1665

commencement of the employment in a state of investment or not, whether they came into his possession before or after the commencement of this section, and whether they comprise the whole or any part of the trust estate to which they belong; and
(b) Pay or transfer any such trust funds to the trustee corporation so employed.
(3) Without prejudice to such general power of appointing agents –
(a) A trustee may appoint a solicitor to be his agent to receive and give
a discharge for any money or valuable consideration or property
receivable by the trustee under the trust by permitting the solicitor
to have the custody of, and to produce a deed or instrument having
in the body of it or endorsed on it a receipt for the money or valuable
consideration or property, the deed or instrument being executed,
or the endorsed receipt being signed, by the person entitled to give
a receipt for that consideration;
(b) A trustee shall not be chargeable with breach of trust by reason
only of his having made or concurred in making any such
appointment; and the production of any such deed or instrument
by the solicitor shall have the same validity and effect as if the person
appointing the solicitor had not been a trustee;
(c) A trustee may appoint a bank or solicitor to be his agent to receive
and give a discharge for any money payable to the trustee under or
by virtue of a policy of insurance, by permitting the bank or solicitor
to have the custody of and to produce the policy of insurance with
a receipt signed by the trustee, and a trustee shall not be chargeable
with a breach of trust by reason only of his having made or
concurred in making any such appointment.
(3) Nothing in subsection (2) shall exempt a trustee from any liability which
he would have incurred if this Act and any enactment replaced by this Act had
not been passed, in case he permits any such money, valuable consideration, or
property to remain in the hands or under the control of the bank or solicitor for a
period longer than is reasonably necessary to enable the bank or solicitor, as the
case may be, to pay or transfer the same to the trustee.

30 Power to concur with others

Where an undivided share in any property is subject to a trust, the trustee
may (without prejudice to any trust or power in relation to the entirety of the
property) execute or exercise any trust or power vested in him in relation to that
share in conjunction with the persons entitled to or having power in that behalf
over the other share or shares, and notwithstanding that the trustee or any one or
more of several trustees may be entitled to or interested in any such other share,
either in his or their own right or in a fiduciary capacity.

31 Power to delegate trusts

(1) A trustee who –
(a) Is for the time being out of Niue or is about to depart from it; or
(b) Expects that he may be absent from Niue during the administration
of the trust; or
(c) Is or may be about to become temporarily incapable, by reason of
physical infirmity, of performing all his duties as trustee; or
(d) Expects that he may be from time to time temporarily incapable,
by reason of physical infirmity, of performing all his duties as a
trustee –
1666 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
may, notwithstanding any rule of law or equity to the contrary, by power of attorney executed as a deed, delegate to any person the execution or exercise, during any period for which the trustee may be absent from Niue or incapable of performing all his duties as a trustee, of all or any trusts, powers, authorities, and discretions vested in him as such trustee, whether alone or jointly with any other person or persons:
Provided that a person being the only other co-trustee and not being a trustee corporation shall not be appointed to be an attorney under this subsection.
(2) Where any such delegation has been duly made to and accepted by
any person and is for the time being in operation, that person shall have, within
the scope of the delegation, the same trusts, powers, authorities, discretions,
liabilities, and responsibilities as he would have if he were then the trustee.
(3) In any proceedings brought by any person beneficially interested under
the trust against the donor of a power of attorney given under this section in
respect of any act or default of the donee of the power it shall be a defence for the
donor to prove that the donee was appointed by him in good faith and without
negligence.
(4) All jurisdiction and powers of any Court shall apply to the donee of
the power of attorney in the same manner, so far as respects the execution of the
trust or the administration of the estate to which the power of attorney relates, as
if the donee were acting in relation to the trust or estate in the same capacity as the
donor of the power.
(5) The power of attorney shall not come into operation unless and until
the donor is out of Niue or is incapable of performing all his duties as a trustee,
and unless the deed otherwise provides shall be deemed to be revoked by his
return or by his recovery of that capacity, as the case may be.
(6) In favour of any person dealing with the donee of a power of attorney
given under this section, any act done or instrument executed by the donee shall,
notwithstanding that the power has never come into operation or has been revoked,
whether by the Act of the donor of the power or by operation of law, be as valid
and effectual as if the power had come into operation and remained unrevoked at
the time when the act was done or the instrument executed, unless that person
had at that time actual notice that the power had never come into operation or of
the revocation of the power.
(7) A statutory declaration by the donee of a power of attorney relating to
any trust or estate that the power has come into operation, or that in any transaction
the donee is acting in the execution of the trust or the administration of the estate,
shall in favour of a person dealing with the donee of the power be conclusive
evidence of that fact.
(8) The fact that it appears from any power of attorney given under this
section, or from any evidence required for the purposes of any power of attorney
or otherwise, that in any transaction the donee of the power is acting in the
execution of a trust shall not be deemed for any purpose to affect any person
dealing in good faith with the donee with any notice of the trust.
(9) For the purpose of executing or exercising the trusts, powers, authorities,
and discretions delegated to him the donee may exercise any of the powers,
authorities and discretions conferred on the donor as trustee by statute or by the
instrument creating the trust, except the power of delegation conferred by this
section.

Trustee Act 1956 1667

32 Power to carry on business

(1) Subject to any other Act, if at the time of his death any person (whether
alone or in partnership) is engaged in carrying on a business, trade, or occupation,
it shall be lawful for his trustee to continue to carry on the same in the same manner
for any one or more of the following periods –
(a) 2 years from the death of that person;
(b) Such period as may be necessary or desirable for the winding up of
the business;
(c) Such further period or periods as the Court may approve.
(2) In exercise of the powers conferred by this section or by the instrument
creating the trust, a trustee may employ any part of the deceased’s estate which is
subject to the same trusts; and may increase or diminish the part of the estate so
employed; and may purchase stock, machinery, implements, and chattels for the
purposes of the business; and may employ such managers, agents, servants, clerks,
workmen, and others as he thinks fit; and may at any time enter into a partnership
agreement to take the place of any partnership agreement subsisting immediately
before the death of the deceased or at any time after it.
(3) Application to the Court for leave to carry on a business may be made
by the trustee or any person beneficially interested in the estate at any time, whether
or not any previous authority to carry on the business has expired; and the Court
may make such an order, or may order that the business be not carried on, or be
carried on subject to conditions, or may make such other order as in the
circumstances seems proper.
(4) Nothing in this section shall prejudice any other authority to do the
acts thereby authorised to be done.
(5) Where a trustee is in any manner interested or concerned in a trade or
business, he may make such subscription as it would be prudent for him to make
if he were acting for himself out of the income of the assets affected to any fund
created for objects or purposes in support of trades or businesses of a like nature
and subscribed to by other persons engaged in the like trade or business.

33 Power to convert business into a company

A trustee may at any time, at the expense of the trust property, convert or
join in converting any business into a company limited by shares in such manner
as he may think fit; and may, at the like expense, promote and assist in promoting
a company for taking over the business; and may sell or transfer the business and
the capital and assets and goodwill of it, or any part of it, to the company, or to
any company having for its objects the purchase of such a business, in consideration
in either case, wholly or in part of ordinary or preference shares wholly or partially
paid up of any such company, or wholly or in part of debentures, debenture stock,
or bonds of any such company, and as to the balance (if any) in cash payable
immediately, or by any instalments with or without security.

33A Trustee may sue himself in a different capacity

(1) Notwithstanding any rule of law or practice to the contrary, a trustee
of any property in that capacity may sue, and be sued by, himself in any other
capacity whatsoever, including his personal capacity.
(2) In every such case the trustee shall obtain the directions of the Court in
which the proceedings are taken as to the manner in which the opposing interests
are to be represented.
1668 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Indemnities

34 Protection against liability in respect of rents and covenants

(1) Where a trustee liable as such for –
(a) Any rent, covenant, or agreement reserved by or contained in any
lease; or
(b) Any rent, covenant or agreement payable under or contained in
any grant made in consideration of a rentcharge; or
(c) Any indemnity given in respect of any rent, covenant or agreement
referred to in paragraph (a) or (b) –
satisfies all liabilities under the lease or grant which may have accrued and been
claimed up to the date of the conveyance hereinafter mentioned, and, where
necessary, sets apart a sufficient fund to answer any future claim that may be
made in respect of any fixed and ascertained sum which the lessee or grantee
agreed to lay out on the property demised or granted, although the period for
laying out the same may not have arrived, then and in any such case the trustee
may convey the property demised or granted to a purchaser, legatee, devisee, or
other person entitled to call for a conveyance of it, and after it –
(i) He may distribute the trust estate (other than the fund, if any,
set apart as aforesaid) to or amongst the persons entitled to it,
without appropriating any part, or any further part, as the case
may be, of the trust estate to meet any future liability under
the said lease or grant;
(ii) Notwithstanding the distribution, he shall not personally be
liable in respect of any subsequent claim under the said lease
or grant.
(2) For the purposes of this section a trustee shall be deemed to be liable as
such for any liabilities arising from privity of estate which he may incur under the
obligations contained in a lease or grant if he is entitled to reimburse himself out
of the trust property for all expenses he may incur in respect of the liabilities.
(3) This section operates without prejudice to the right of the lessor or
grantor, or the persons deriving title under the lessor or grantor, to follow the
trust property or any part of it or any property representing the same into the
hands of the persons amongst whom the same may have been respectively
distributed, and applies notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the
instrument, if any, creating the trust.
(4) In this section “lease” includes a sublease and an agreement for a lease
or sublease and any instrument giving any such indemnity as aforesaid or varying
the liabilities under the lease; “grant” applies to a grant whether the rent is created
by limitation, grant, reservation, or otherwise, and includes an agreement for a
grant and any instrument giving any such indemnity as aforesaid or varying the
liabilities under the grant; and “lessee” and “grantee” include persons respectively
deriving title under them.

34A Lien on policy money for premiums

Where a trustee pays any premiums in respect of any policy of insurance
he shall have a lien on the policy money for the amount of the premiums so paid,
together with interest on it at the rate of 6 percent.

35 Protection against creditors

(1) (a) Where a trustee has given notice by advertisement published at
least once in a newspaper circulating in each locality in which in
the pinion of the trustee claims are likely to arise requiring persons

Trustee Act 1956 1669

having claims to which this section applies to send to the trustee, within the time fixed in the notice, particulars of their claims and warning them of the consequences of their failure to do so, then, at the expiration of that time or at any time after it the trustee may administer or distribute the property or any part of it to which the notice relates to or among the persons entitled to it having regard only to the claims, whether formal or not, of which the trustee then has notice; and he shall not, as respects the property so administered or distributed, be liable to any person of whose claim he has not had notice at the time of the administration or distribution.
(b) Nothing in this section shall prejudice any remedy which the person may have under section 49 of the Administration Act 1969 or any other right or remedy available to him against any person other than the trustee, including any right which he may have to follow the property and any money or property into which it is converted.
(2) (a) The time to be fixed as aforesaid by any such notice shall not be less than one month from the date on which the notice is given.
(b) Where the notice is given in a newspaper circulating mainly outside
Niue the time to be fixed as aforesaid shall be not less than 2 months.
(3) In any case where the personal representative of a deceased person
gives any such notice, the localities specified in subsection (1) shall include each
locality in which the deceased resided or carried on business at any time during
the year immediately preceding his death.
(4) Where the trustee is in doubt as to what advertisements should be
published under this section he may apply to the Court for directions.
(5) Any advertisement published under this section may relate to more
than one estate or trust property.
(6) This section shall apply notwithstanding anything to the contrary in
the instrument, if any, creating the trust.
(7) Except as provided in subsection (8) this section shall apply to the claims,
whether present or future, certain or contingent, against a trustee personally by
reason of his being under any liability in respect of which he is entitled to reimburse
himself out of the estate or property that he is administering.
(8) This section shall not apply to –
(a) Any claim arising out of any contract to make a will containing
certain provisions or not to revoke an existing will or a specified
provision therein or not to make a will; or
(b) Any claim by a person to be a beneficiary under the will or to be
entitled on the intestacy of the deceased person or to be beneficially
interested under the trust.

36 Protection in regard to notice

A trustee acting for the purposes of more than one trust shall not, in the
absence of fraud, be affected by notice of any instrument, matter, fact, or thing in relation to any particular trust if he has obtained notice of it merely by reason of his acting or having acted for the purposes of another trust.
1670 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

37 Exoneration of trustees in respect of certain powers of attorney

(1) A trustee acting or paying money in good faith in reliance on any power
of attorney and on a statutory declaration or other sufficient evidence that the
power of attorney has not been revoked shall not be liable for any such act or
payment by reason of the fact that at the time of the act or payment the person
who gave the power of attorney was subject to any disability, or bankrupt, or
dead, or had done or suffered some act or thing to avoid the power, if this fact was
not known to the trustee at the time of his so acting or paying.
(2) (a) Nothing in this section shall affect the right of any person entitled
to the money against the person to whom the payment is made.
(b) The person so entitled shall have the same remedy against the
person to whom the payment is made as he would have had against
the trustee.

38 Implied indemnity of trustees

(1) A trustee shall be chargeable only for money and securities actually
received by him, notwithstanding his signing any receipt for the sake of conformity,
and shall be answerable and accountable only for his own acts, receipts, neglects,
or defaults, and not for those of any other trustee, nor for any bank, broker or
other person with whom any trust money or securities may be deposited, nor for
the insufficiency or deficiency of any securities, nor for any other loss unless the
same happens through his own wilful default.
(2) (a) A trustee may reimburse himself or pay or discharge out of the
trust property all expenses reasonably incurred in or about the
execution of the trusts or powers; but, except as provided in this
Act or any other Act or as agreed by the persons beneficially
interested under the trust, no trustee shall be allowed the costs of
any professional services performed by him in the execution of the
trusts or powers unless the contrary is expressly declared by the
instrument creating the trust.
(b) The Court may on the application of the trustee allow such costs as
in the circumstances seem just.

39 Protection of trustee who pays trust money to bankrupt

(1) (a) If a trustee in good faith, without negligence, and without actual
knowledge of the bankruptcy of any person, pays or transfers to or
to the order of that person any trust money or trust property which
he would have been entitled to receive (whether as a beneficiary or
otherwise) if he had not been adjudged bankrupt, the trustee shall
not be liable to the assignee in bankruptcy of the estate of the
bankrupt for any money so paid or any property so transferred.
(b) Nothing in this section shall prejudice the right of the assignee in
bankruptcy to follow the money or property or any part of it into
the hands of the persons who have received the same.
(2) For the purposes of this section a trustee shall not be deemed to have
actual knowledge of the bankruptcy of any person by reason merely of the fact
that notice of the adjudication has been published in any newspaper or in the

Gazette.

Trustee Act 1956 1671

39A Protection of trustee in handing over chattels to life tenant
(1) Where any chattels are, under the provisions of any will, bequeathed
to any person including an infant for life or for any limited interest, the trustee
may cause an inventory to be made of the chattels, which inventory shall be signed
by that person and retained by the trustee, and a copy of the inventory shall be
delivered to that person.
(2) The trustee may thereupon deliver the chattels to that person on such
terms and conditions as the trustee thinks fit, and shall not after it be bound to see
to the repair or insurance of the chattels, and shall not be subject to any liability
whatsoever by reason of the loss or destruction of the chattels or the neglect of
that person to effect any such repairs or insurance.
(3) A copy of any such inventory, signed by that person and by the trustee
shall be deemed to be an instrument within the meaning of the Chattels Transfer
Act 1924, and may be registered accordingly.

39B Protection of trustee in handing over chattels to infant

(1) a trustee may in his discretion deliver to an infant, or to the guardian
or any of the guardians of an infant, any chattels absolutely vested in the infant,
and the receipt of the infant or guardian shall be a complete discharge to the trustee
for any chattels so delivered.
(2) The powers conferred by this section are in addition to the powers
conferred by section 41 and, for the purposes of section 41(2)(b) the value of the
chattels delivered under this section shall not be taken into account in any way.

Maintenance, Advancement and Protective Trusts

40 Power to apply income for maintenance

(1) Where any property is held by a trustee in trust for any person for any
interest whatsoever, whether vested or contingent, then, any prior interests or charges affecting that property –
(a) During the infancy of any such person, if his interest so long continues, the trustee may, at his sole discretion, pay to his parent or guardian, if any, or otherwise apply for or towards his maintenance or education (including past maintenance or education) or his advancement or benefit, the whole or such part, if any, of the income of that property as may, in all the circumstances be reasonable, whether or not there is –
(i) Any other fund applicable to the same purpose; or
(ii) Any person bound by law to provide for his maintenance,
education, advancement, or benefit; and
(b) If the person on attaining the age of 20 years has not a vested interest
in that income, the trustee shall thenceforth pay the income of that
property and of any accretion to it under subsection (2) to him until
he either attains a vested interest in it or dies, or until failure of his
interest;
Provided that, in deciding whether the whole or any part of the income of the
property is during a minority to be paid or applied for the purposes aforesaid, the
trustee shall have regard to the age of the infant and his requirements and generally
to the circumstances of the case, and in particular to what other income, if any, is
applicable for the same purposes; and where the trustee has notice that the income
of more than one fund is applicable for those purposes, then, so far as practicable,
unless the entire income of the funds is paid or applied as aforesaid or the Court
otherwise directs, a proportionate part only of the income of each fund shall be so
paid or applied.
1672

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(2) During the infancy of any such person, if his interest so long continues, the trustee shall accumulate all the residue of that income in the way of compound interest by investing the same and the resulting income of it in authorised investments, and shall hold those accumulations as follows –
(a) If any such person –
(i) Attains the age of 20 years, or marries under that age, and his
interest in the income during his infancy or until his marriage
is a vested interest; or
(ii) On attaining the age of 20 years or on marriage under that age
becomes entitled to the property from which the income arose
in fee simple absolute or determinable, or absolutely –
the trustee shall hold the accumulations in trust for that person
absolutely, but without prejudice to any provision with respect to
it contained in any settlement by him made under any statutory
powers during his infancy, and so that the receipt of that person
after marriage, and though still an infant, shall be a good discharge;
and
(b) In any other case the trustee shall, notwithstanding that that person
had a vested interest in the income, hold the accumulations as an
accretion to the capital of the property from which the accumulations
arose and as one fund with that capital for all purposes –
but the trustee may, at any time during the infancy of that person if his interest so
long continues, apply those accumulations, or any part of it, as if they were income
arising in the then current year.
(3) This section applies in the case of a contingent interest only if the
limitation or trust carries the intermediate income of the property, but it applies to
a future or contingent legacy by the parent of, or a person standing in the place of
a parent to, the legatee, if and for such period as, under the general law, the legacy
carries interest for the maintenance of the legatee, and in any such case as last
aforesaid the rate of interest shall (if the income available is sufficient and subject
to any rules of Court to the contrary) be that for the time being prescribed by or
under section 39 of the Administration Act 1969.
(4) This section applies to a vested annuity in like manner as if the annuity
were the income of property held by a trustee in trust to pay the income of it to the
annuitant for the same period for which the annuity is payable, save that in any
case accumulations made during the infancy of the annuitant shall be held in
trust for the annuitant or his personal representatives absolutely.

41 Power to apply capital for maintenance

(1) A trustee may at any time or times pay or apply any capital money or
other capital asset subject to a trust, for the maintenance or education (including past maintenance or education), or the advancement or benefit, in such manner as he may in his absolute discretion think fit, of any person entitled to the capital of the trust property or of any share of it, whether absolutely or contingently on his attaining any specified age or on the occurrence of any other event, or subject to a gift over on his death under any specified age or on the occurrence of any other event, and whether in possession or in remainder or reversion, and any such payment or application may be made notwithstanding that the interest of that person is liable to be defeated by the exercise of a power of appointment or revocation, or to be diminished by the increase of the class to which he belongs.
(2) (a) The money or asset so paid or applied for the maintenance, education, advancement, or benefit of any person shall not exceed

Trustee Act 1956 1673

altogether half of the presumptive or vested share or interest of that person in the trust property where the value of that share or interest exceeds $2,000 and in any other case shall not exceed altogether $1,000 in amount or value; and
(b) Where that person or any other person is or becomes absolutely and indefeasibly entitled to the share of the trust property in which that person had presumptive or vested interest when the money or asset was so paid or applied, that money or asset shall be brought into account as part of that share in the trust property; and
(c) No such payment or application shall be made so as to prejudice any person entitled to any prior life or other interest, whether vested or contingent, in the money or asset paid or applied unless that person is in existence and of full age and consents in writing to the payment or application, or unless the Court, on the application of the trustee so orders.

41A Conditional advances for maintenance

(1) (a) Where a power to pay or apply any property for the maintenance,
education, advancement, or benefit of any person, or for any one
or more of those purposes, is vested in a trustee, the trustee when
exercising the power shall have, and be deemed always to have
had, authority to impose on the person any condition, whether as
to repayment, payment of interest, giving security, or otherwise.
(b) At any time after imposing any such condition, the trustee may,
either wholly or in part, waive the condition or release any
obligation undertaken or any security given by reason of the
condition.
(2) In determining the amount or value of the property which a trustee
who has imposed such a condition may pay or apply in exercise of the power, any
money repaid to the trustee or recovered by him shall be deemed not to have been
so paid or applied by the trustee.
(3) Nothing in this section shall impose upon a trustee any obligation to
impose any such condition; and a trustee, when imposing any condition as to
giving security as aforesaid, shall not be affected by any restrictions upon the
investment of trust funds, whether imposed by this Act or by any rule of law or
by the trust instrument (if any).
(4) A trustee shall not be liable for any loss which may be incurred in respect
of any money that is paid or applied as aforesaid, whether the loss arises through
failure to take security, or through the security being insufficient, or through failure
to take action for its protection, or through the release or abandonment of the
security without payment, or from any other cause.

42 Protective trusts

(1) Where any income, including an annuity or other periodical income
payment, is directed to be held on protective trusts for the benefit of any person (in this section called the principal beneficiary) for the period of his life or for any less period, then during that period (in this section called the trust period) the said income shall, without prejudice to any prior interest, be held on the following trusts, namely –
(a) Upon trust for the principal beneficiary during the trust period or
until he, whether before or after the termination of any prior interest,
does or attempts to do or suffers any act or thing, or until any event
1674

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

happens, other than an advance under any statutory or express power, whereby, if the said income were payable during the trust period to the principal beneficiary absolutely during that period, he would be deprived of the right to receive the same or any part of it, in any of which cases, as well as on the termination of the trust period, whichever first happens, this trust of the said income shall fail or determine;
(b) If the trust aforesaid fails or determines during the subsistence of the trust period, then, during the residue of that period, the said income shall be held upon trust for the application of it for the maintenance or support, or otherwise for the benefit, of all or any one or more exclusively of the other or others of the following persons, that is to say –
(i) The principal beneficiary and his or her wife or husband, if any, and his or her children or more remote issue, if any; or
(ii) If there is no wife or husband or issue of the principal beneficiary in existence, the principal beneficiary and the persons who would, if he were actually dead, be entitled to the trust property or the income of it or to the annuity fund, if any, or arrears of the annuity, as the case may be;
as the trustee in his absolute discretion, without being liable to
account for the exercise of such discretion, thinks fit.
(2) This section shall not apply to trusts coming into operation before the
commencement of this Act, and has effect subject to any variation of the implied
trusts aforesaid contained in the instrument creating the trust.
(3) Nothing in this section shall operate to validate any trust which would,
if contained in the instrument creating the trust, be liable to be set aside.
PART 4
APPOINTMENT AND DISCHARGE OF TRUSTEES

43 Power of appointing new trustees

(1) Where a trustee (whether original or substituted, and whether
appointed by the Court or otherwise) – (a) Is dead; or
(b) Remains out of Niue for the space of 12 months during which no
delegation of any trusts, powers, or discretions vested in him as
such trustee remains in operation under section 31; or
(c) Desires to be discharged from all or any of the trusts or powers
reposed in or conferred on him; or
(d) Refuses to act; or
(e) Is unfit to act; or
(f) Is incapable of so acting; or
(g) Being a corporation, has ceased to carry on business, is in
liquidation, or is dissolved, then –
the person nominated for the purpose of appointing new trustees by the instrument
(if any) creating the trust, or if there is no such person or no such person able and
willing to act, then the surviving or continuing trustees for the time being, or the
personal representatives of the last surviving or continuing trustee, may by deed
appoint a person or persons (whether or not being the person or persons exercising
the power) to be a trustee or trustees in the place of the first-mentioned trustee.

Trustee Act 1956 1675

(2) On the appointment of a trustee or trustees for the whole or any part of trust property –
(a) The number of trustees may be increased; and
(b) A separate set of trustees may be appointed for any part of the trust
property held on trusts distinct from those relating to any other
part, and whether or not new trustees are or are to be appointed for
other parts of the trust property; and any existing trustee may be
appointed or remain one of the separate set of trustees; or if only
one trustee was originally appointed, then one separate trustee may
be so appointed for the first-mentioned part; and
(c) It shall not be obligatory to appoint more than one new trustee
where only one trustee was originally appointed, or to fill up the
original number of trustees where more than 2 trustees were
originally appointed; but, except where only one trustee was
originally appointed, a trustee shall not be discharged under this
section unless there will be either a trustee corporation or at least
two individuals to act as trustees to perform the trust; and
(d) Any assurance or thing requisite for vesting the trust property, or
any part thereof, jointly in the persons who are the trustees shall be
executed or done.
(3) Where a trustee has been removed under a power contained in the
instrument creating the trust, a new trustee or new trustees may be appointed in
the place of the trustee who is removed, as if he were dead, or, in the case of a
corporation, as if the corporation had been dissolved, and this section shall apply
accordingly.
(4) (a) The power of appointment given by subsection (1) or any similar
previous enactment to the personal representatives of a last
surviving or continuing trustee shall be and shall be deemed always
to have been exercisable by the executors for the time being (whether
original or by representation) of that surviving or continuing trustee
who have proved the will of their testator or by the administrators
for the time being of that trustee without the concurrence of any
executor who has renounced or has not proved.
(b) A sole or last surviving executor intending to renounce, or all the
executors where they all intend to renounce, shall have and shall
be deemed always to have had power, at any time before renouncing
probate, to exercise the power of appointment given by this section,
or by any similar previous enactment, if willing to act for that
purpose and without thereby accepting the office of executor.
(5) Where a sole trustee is or has been originally appointed to act in a trust,
or where, in the case of any trust, there are not more than three trustees either
original or substituted and whether appointed by the Court or otherwise, then
and in any such case –
(a) The person or persons nominated for the purpose of appointing
new trustees by the instrument, if any, creating the trust; or
(b) If there is no such person, or no such person able and willing to act,
then the trustee or trustees for the time being –
may, by writing, appoint a person or persons (whether or not being the person or
persons exercising the power) to be an additional trustee or additional trustees,
but it shall not be obligatory to appoint any additional trustee, unless the
instrument, if any, creating the trust, or any statutory enactment provides to the
contrary:
1676 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
Provided that an additional trustee or additional trustees shall not be appointed under this subsection without the consent of –
(a) The trustee or trustees for the time being; or
(b) The Court.
(6) Every new trustee appointed under this section as well before as after
all the trust property becomes by law, or by assurance, or otherwise, vested in
him, shall have the same powers, authorities, and discretions, and may in all
respects act as if he had been originally appointed a trustee by the instrument, if
any, creating the trust.
(7) The provisions of this section relative to a trustee who is dead include
the case of a person nominated trustee whether sole or otherwise in a will, and
who dies before the testator; and those relative to a continuing trustee include a
refusing or retiring trustee, if willing to act in the execution of the provisions of
this section.
(8) The provisions of this section relative to a person nominated for the
purpose of appointing new trustees apply whether the appointment is made in a
case specified in this section or in a case specified in the instrument, if any, creating
the trust, but where a new trustee is appointed under this section in a case specified
in that instrument, the appointment shall be subject to the terms applicable to an
appointment in that case under the provisions of that instrument.
(9) In this section “trustee” does not include a personal representative as
such.

44 Evidence as to a vacancy in a trust

(1) A statement contained in any instrument coming into operation after
the commencement of this Act by which a new trustee is appointed for any purpose
connected with land as to how a vacancy in the office of trustee occurred shall, in
favour of a purchaser of the land, be conclusive evidence of the matter stated.
(2) In favour of any such purchaser any appointment of a new trustee
depending on that statement, and any vesting declaration, express or implied,
consequent on the appointment, shall be valid.

45 Retirement of trustee

(1) Where there are 2 or more trustees –
(a) If one of them by deed declares that he is desirous of being
discharged from the trust, and
(b) If his co-trustees and such other person (if any) as is empowered to
appoint trustees by deed consent to the discharge of the trustee,
and to the vesting of the trust property in the co-trustees alone –
then, subject to subsection (3), the trustee desirous of being discharged shall be
deemed to have retired from the trust, and shall by deed be discharged from it
under this Act without any new trustee being appointed in his place.
(2) Any assurance or thing requisite for vesting the trust property in the
continuing trustees alone shall be executed and done.
(3) Except where only one trustee was originally appointed, a trustee shall
not be discharged under subsection (1) unless there will be either a trustee
corporation or at least 2 individuals to act as trustees to perform the trust.

46 Discharge of trustee

(1) Where any trustee is desirous of being discharged from his trust he
shall be entitled to retire from it on passing his accounts before the Registrar, and
giving notice of his retirement to his co-trustees (if any), and to such other person
(if any) as is empowered to appoint new trustees.

Trustee Act 1956 1677

(2) If such co-trustees, or such other person, as aforesaid empowered to appoint new trustees, or any of them, refuse or neglect to appoint a new trustee or to consent to such appointment in place of the trustee so retiring, or if the retiring trustee is the sole trustee having power to appoint a new trustee, but the exercise of that power is impracticable or difficult without the assistance of the Court, it shall be lawful for the retiring trustee to apply to the Court for the appointment of a new trustee in his place.
(3) The Court may, upon any such application, make an order appointing some proper person as trustee in place of the trustee so desirous of being discharged from his trust, and direct any accounts and inquiries to be made, and make an order discharging the trustee from the trust and from all liability in respect of it, and may make such order as to costs or otherwise as it thinks fit, and may exercise any of the powers contained in Part 5 and the person who upon the making of the order becomes trustee shall have the same rights and powers as he would have had if appointed by judgment in an action duly instituted.

47 Vesting of trust property in new or continuing trustees

(1) Where by a deed a new trustee is appointed to perform any trust then –
(a) If the deed contains a declaration by the appointor to the effect that
any estate or interest in any land that is subject to the trust or in any
chattel so subject, or the right to recover or receive any debt or other
thing in action so subject, shall vest in the persons who by virtue of
the deed become or are the trustees for performing the trust, the
deed shall operate, without any conveyance or assignment, to vest
in those persons as joint tenants and for the purposes of the trust
the estate or interest or right to which the declaration relates; and
(b) If the deed is made after the commencement of this Act and does
not contain such a declaration, the deed shall, subject to any express
provision to the contrary in it contained, operate as if it had
contained such a declaration by the appointed extending to all the
estates, interests, and rights with respect to which a declaration
could have been made.
(2) Where by a deed a retiring trustee is discharged under the statutory
power without a new trustee being appointed, then –
(a) If the deed contains such a declaration as aforesaid by the retiring
and continuing trustees, and by the other person (if any) empowered
to appoint trustees, the deed shall, without any conveyance or
assignment, operate to vest in the continuing trustees alone, as joint
tenants, and for the purposes of the trust, the estate or interest or
right to which the declaration relates; and
(b) If the deed is made after the commencement of this Act and does
not contain such a declaration, the deed shall, subject to any express
provision to the contrary in it contained, operate as if it had
contained such a declaration by such persons as aforesaid extending
to all the estates, interests, and rights with respect to which a
declaration could have been made.
(3) An express vesting declaration, whether made before or after the
commencement of this Act shall, notwithstanding that the estate or interest or
right to be vested is not expressly referred to, and provided that the other statutory
requirements were or are complied with, operate and be deemed always to have
operated (but without prejudice to any express provision to the contrary contained
in the deed of appointment or discharge) to vest in the persons respectively referred
1678 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
to in subsections (1) and (2), as the case may require, such estates, interests, and rights as are capable of being and ought to be vested in those persons.
(4) This section does not extend –
(a) To land conveyed by way of mortgage for securing money subject
to the trust, except land conveyed on trust for securing debentures
or debenture stock;
(b) To land held under a lease (including a sublease and an agreement
for a lease or sublease) which contains any covenant, condition, or
agreement against assignment or disposing of the land without
licence or consent, unless (before the execution of the deed
containing expressly or impliedly the vesting declaration) the
requisite licence or consent has been obtained, or unless (by virtue
of any statute or rule of law) the vesting declaration, express or
implied, would not operate as a breach of covenant or give rise to a
forfeiture;
(c) To any share, stock, annuity, or property which is transferable only
in books kept by a company or other body, or in the manner directed
by or under any Act.
(5) For purposes of registration of the deed in any registry, the person or
persons making the declaration expressly or impliedly shall be deemed the
conveying party or parties, and the conveyance shall be deemed to be made by
him or them under a power conferred by this Act.

48 Corporations acting as trustees

(1) (a) Any trustee corporation may be appointed and may lawfully act as
the sole trustee in respect of any trust, notwithstanding that the
instrument creating the trust may provide for or direct the
appointment of 2 or more trustees.
(b) Nothing in this subsection shall prevent any other corporation from
acting as a trustee under any authority vested in it in that behalf,
whether by its memorandum of association or otherwise.
(c) No corporation shall administer the estate of any deceased person
unless expressly authorised to do so by any Act.
(2) This section shall not permit the appointment of a corporation as trustee
if the instrument creating the trust forbids the appointment of the corporation.
(3) This section shall extend to all trusts and instruments, and to all
appointments of trustees, whether created or made before or after the
commencement of this Act.

49 Advisory trustees

(1) In the administration of any trust property any trustee may act, to the
extent hereinafter provided, with an advisory trustee, which term includes, in its
application to the estate of a mentally defective person, an advisory committee or
advisory administrator of the estate.
(2) An advisory trustee may be appointed in respect of all or any part of
the trust property –
(a) By the testator, settlor, or other creator of the trust, in the instrument
creating the trust; or
(b) By order of the Court made on the application of any beneficiary or
trustee or of any person on whose application the Court would
have power to appoint a new trustee; or
(c) By the responsible trustee or any person having power to appoint a
new trustee; or

Trustee Act 1956 1679

(d) In respect of the estate of a mentally defective person, by order of the Court made on the application of the committee or person authorised to administer the estate.
(3) Where a trustee acts with an advisory trustee the trust property shall be vested in the first-mentioned trustee (in this section referred to as the responsible trustee), who shall have the sole management and administration of the estate and its trusts as fully and effectually as if he were the sole trustee:
Provided that –
(a) The responsible trustee may consult the advisory trustee on any
matter relating to the trusts or the estate;
(b) The advisory trustee may advise the responsible trustee on any
matter relating to the trusts or the estate, but shall not be a trustee
in respect of the trust;
(c) Where any advice or direction is tendered or given by the advisory
trustee, the responsible trustee may follow the same and act on it
and shall not be liable for anything done or omitted by him by reason
of his following that advice or direction;
(d) In any case where the responsible trustee is of opinion that such
advice or direction conflicts with the trusts or any rule of law, or
exposes him to any liability, or is otherwise objectionable, he may
apply to the Court for directions in the matter, and the decision
and order in it shall be final and shall bind the responsible trustee
and the advisory trustee, and the court may make such order as to
costs as appears proper:
Provided that nothing in this paragraph shall make it necessary for
the responsible trustee to apply to the Court for any such directions.
(e) Where advisory trustees are not unanimous, and tender to the
responsible trustee conflicting advice or directions, the responsible
trustee may similarly apply to the Court for directions;
(4) No person dealing with the responsible trustee in relation to any trust
property shall be concerned to inquire as to the concurrence or otherwise of the
advisory trustee, or be affected by notice of the fact that the advisory trustee has
not concurred.
(5) Subject to the provisions of the instrument (if any) creating the trust
and to any order made by the Court, in any case where remuneration is payable
to the trustee of any trust property, remuneration or commission may be paid to
both the responsible trustee and the advisory trustee, and subject as aforesaid the
amount of it shall be determined by the responsible trustee if he is entitled to fix
his own remuneration, or by the Court.

50 Custodian trustees

(1) Subject to this section and to the instrument (if any) creating the trust,
any corporation may be appointed to be custodian trustee of any trust in any case where it could be appointed to be trustee, in the same manner as it could be so appointed.
(2) Subject to the provisions of the instrument (if any) creating the trust, where a custodian trustee is appointed of any trust –
(a) The trust property shall be vested in the custodian trustee as if the custodian trustee were sole trustee, and for that purpose vesting orders may, where necessary, be made under this Act;
1680 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) The management of the trust property and the exercise of all powers and discretions exercisable by the trustee under the trust shall remain vested in the managing trustees as fully and effectually as if there were no custodian trustee;
(c) The sole function of the custodian trustee shall be to get in and hold the trust property, and invest its funds, and dispose of the assets, as the managing trustees in writing direct, for which purpose the custodian trustee shall execute all such documents and perform all such acts as the managing trustees in writing direct;
(d) For the purposes of paragraph (c) a direction given by the majority of the managing trustees where there are more than one, shall be deemed to be given by all the managing trustees;
(e) The custodian trustee shall not be liable for acting on any such direction:
Provided that if the custodian trustee is of opinion that any such
direction conflicts with the trusts or the law, or exposes the custodian
trustee to any liability, or is otherwise objectionable, the custodian
trustee may apply to the Court for directions under section 66; and
any order giving any such directions shall bind both the custodian
trustee and the managing trustees; and the Court may make such
order as to costs as it thinks proper;
(f) The custodian trustee shall not be liable for any act or default on
the part of any of the managing trustees;
(g) All actions and proceedings touching or concerning the trust
property shall be brought or defended in the name of the custodian
trustee at the written direction of the managing trustees, and the
custodian trustee shall not be liable for the costs of it apart from the
trust property;
(h) No person dealing with the custodian trustee shall be concerned to
inquire as to the concurrence or otherwise of the managing trustees,
or be affected by notice of the fact that the managing trustees have
not concurred;
(i) The power of appointing new trustees, when exercisable by the
trustee, shall be exercisable by the managing trustees alone, but the
custodian trustee shall have the same power as any other trustee of
applying to the Court for the appointment of a new trustee.
(3) On the application of the custodian trustee, or of any of the managing
trustees, or of any beneficiary, and on satisfactory proof that it is the general wish
of the beneficiaries, or that on other grounds it is expedient to terminate the
custodian trusteeship, the Court may make an order for that purpose, and may
also make such vesting orders and give such directions as in the circumstances
seem to the Court to be necessary or expedient.
(4) Subject to the provisions of the instrument (if any) creating the trust
and to any order made by the Court, in any case where remuneration or
commission is payable to the trustee of any trust property, remuneration may be
paid to both the custodian trustee and the managing trustees, and subject as
aforesaid the amount of it shall be determined by the managing trustees if they
are entitled to fix their own remuneration or by the Court.

Trustee Act 1956 1681

PART 5
POWERS OF THE COURT

Appointment of New Trustees

51 Power of Court to appoint new trustees

(1) The Court may, whenever it is expedient to appoint a new trustee or
new trustees, and it is found inexpedient, difficult, or impracticable so to do without
the assistance of the Court, make an order appointing a new trustee or new trustees,
either in substitution for or in addition to any existing trustee or trustees, or
although there is no existing trustee.
(2) In particular and without prejudice to the generality of subsection (1),
the Court may make an order appointing a new trustee in substitution for a trustee
who –
(a) Has been held by the Court to have misconducted himself in the administration of the trust; or
(b) Is convicted, whether summarily or on indictment, of a crime
involving dishonesty; or
(c) Is a mentally defective person; or
(d) Is a bankrupt; or
(e) Is a corporation which has ceased to carry on business, or is in
liquidation, or has been dissolved.
(3) An order under this section and any consequential vesting order or
conveyance, shall not operate further or otherwise as a discharge to any former or
continuing trustee than an appointment of new trustees under any power for that
purpose contained in any instrument would have operated.
(4) Nothing in this section shall give power to appoint an executor or
administrator.
(5) Every trustee appointed by the Court shall, as well before as after the
trust property becomes by law, or by assurance, or otherwise, vested in him, have
the same powers, authorities, and discretions, and may in all respects act as if he
had been originally appointed a trustee by the instrument, if any, creating the
trust.

52 Vesting orders of land

Vesting Orders

(1) Subject to subsections (2) and (3) in any of the following cases, namely – (a) Where the Court appoints or has appointed a trustee of any land or interest in it, or where a trustee of any land or interest in it has been
appointed out of Court under any statutory or express power;
(b) Where a trustee entitled to or possessed of any land or interest in it,
whether by way of mortgage or otherwise, or entitled to a contingent
right in it, either solely or jointly with any other person –
(i) Is under disability; or
(ii) Is out of the jurisdiction of the Court; or
(iii) Cannot be found; or
(iv) Being a corporation, has ceased to carry on business or is in
liquidation or has been dissolved;
(c) Where it is uncertain who was the survivor of 2 or more trustees
jointly entitled to or possessed of any interest in land;
(d) Where it is uncertain whether the last trustee known to have been
entitled to or possessed of any interest in land is alive or dead;
1682 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(e) Where there is no personal representative of a deceased trustee who was entitled to or possessed of any interest in land, or where it is uncertain who is the personal representative of a deceased trustee who was entitled to or possessed of any interest in land;
(f) Where a deceased person was entitled to or possessed of any interest in land and his personal representative is under disability;
(g) Where a trustee jointly or solely entitled to or possessed of any interest in land, or entitled to a contingent right in it, has been required, by or on behalf of a person entitled to require a conveyance of the land or interest or a release of the right, to convey the land or interest or to release the right, and has wilfully refused or neglected to convey the land or interest or release the right for 28 days after the date of the requirement;
(h) Where land or any interest in it is vested in a trustee whether by way of mortgage or otherwise, and it appears to the Court to be expedient –
the Court may make an order (in this Act called a vesting order) vesting the land or interest in it in any such person in any such manner and for any such estate or interest as the Court may direct, or releasing or disposing of the contingent right to such person as the Court may direct.
(2) Where any such order is consequential on the appointment of a trustee,
the land or interest in it shall be vested for such estate as the Court may direct in
the persons who on the appointment are the trustees.
(3) Where any such order relates to a trustee entitled or formerly entitled
jointly with another person, and that trustee is under disability or out of the
jurisdiction of the Court or cannot be found, or (being a corporation) has ceased
to carry on business or is in liquidation or has been dissolved, the land, interest, or
right shall be vested in the other person who remains entitled, either alone or
with any other person that the Court may appoint.

53 Contingent rights of unborn persons

Where any interest in land is subject to a contingent right in an unborn
person or class of unborn persons who, on coming into existence would, in respect
of it, become entitled to or possessed of that interest on any trust, the Court may
make an order releasing the land or interest in it from the contingent right, or may
make an order vesting in any person the estate or interest to or of which the unborn
person or class of unborn persons would, on coming into existence, be entitled or
possessed in the land.

54 Vesting order in place of conveyance by infant mortgagee

Where any person entitled to or possessed of any interest in land, or entitled
to a contingent right in land, by way of security for money, is an infant, the Court
may make an order vesting or releasing or disposing of the interest in the land or
the right in like manner as in the case of a trustee under disability.

55 Vesting order consequential on order for sale or mortgage of land

Where the Court gives a judgment or makes an order directing the sale or
mortgage of any land, every person who is entitled to or possessed of any interest
in the land, or entitled to a contingent right in it, and is a party to the action or
proceeding in which the judgment or order is given or made or is otherwise bound
by the judgment or order, shall be deemed to be so entitled or possessed, as the
case may be, as a trustee for the purposes of this Act, and the Court may if it
thinks expedient make an order vesting the land or any part of it for such estate or
interest as the Court thinks fit in the purchaser or mortgagee or in any other person.

Trustee Act 1956 1683

56 Vesting order consequential on judgment for specific performance

Where a judgment is given for the specific performance of a contract
concerning any interest in land, or for sale or exchange of any interest in land, or
generally where any judgment is given for the conveyance of any interest in land,
either in cases arising out of the doctrine of election or otherwise, the Court may
declare –
(a) That any of the parties to the action are trustees of any interest in the land or any part of it within the meaning of this Act; or
(b) That the interests of unborn persons who might claim under any
party to the action, or under the will or voluntary settlement of any
deceased person who was during his lifetime a party to the contract
or transaction concerning which the judgment is given, are the
interests of persons who, on coming into existence, would be
trustees within the meaning of this Act –
and thereupon the Court may make a vesting order relating to the rights of those
persons, born and unborn, as if they had been trustees.

57 Effect of vesting order

A vesting order under sections 52 to 56 shall, in the case of a vesting order
consequential on the appointment of a trustee, have the same effect –
(a) As if the persons who before the appointment were the trustees, if
any, had duly executed all proper conveyances of the land for such
estate or interests as the Court directs; or
(b) If there is no such person or no such person of full age and full
mental capacity, as if such person had existed and been of full age
and full mental capacity and had duly executed all proper
conveyances of the land for such estate or interest as the Court
directs;
and shall in every other case have the same effect as if the trustee or other person
or description or class of persons to whose rights or supposed rights the said
provisions respectively relate had been an ascertained and existing person of full
age and full mental capacity and had executed a conveyance or release to the
effect intended by the order.

58 Power to appoint person to convey

In all cases where a vesting order can be made under section 52 to 56, the
Court may, if it is more convenient, appoint a person to convey the land or any
interest in it or release the contingent right, and a conveyance, or release by that
person in conformity with the order shall have the same effect as an order under
the appropriate provision.

59 Vesting orders as to stock and things in action

(1) Subject to subsections (2), (3) and (4) in any of the following cases,
namely –
(a) Where the Court appoints or has appointed a trustee, or where a trustee has been appointed out of Court under any statutory or express power;
(b) Where a trustee entitled, whether by way of mortgage or otherwise, alone or jointly with another person to stock or to a thing in action – (i) Is under disability; or
(ii) Is out of the jurisdiction of the Court; or
(iii) Cannot be found; or
1684 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(iv) Being a corporation, has ceased to carry on business or is in liquidation or has been dissolved; or
(v) Neglects or refuses to transfer stock or receive the dividends or income of it, or to sue for or recover a thing in action, under the direction of the person absolutely entitled to it for 28 days next after a request in writing has been made to him by the person so entitled; or
(vi) Neglects or refuses to transfer stock or receive the dividends or income of it or to sue for or recover a thing in action for 28 days next after an order of the Court for that purpose has been served on him;
(c) Where it is uncertain who was the survivor of 2 or more trustees
entitled to stock or to a thing in action;
(d) Where it is uncertain whether a trustee entitled alone or jointly with
another person to stock or to a thing in action is alive or dead;
(e) Where there is no personal representative of a deceased person
entitled to stock or to a thing in action or where it is uncertain who
is the personal representative of a deceased person who is entitled
to stock or to a thing in action;
(f) Where stock is standing in the name of a deceased person whose
personal representative is under disability;
(g) Where stock or a thing in action is vested in a trustee whether by
way of mortgage or otherwise and it appears to the Court to be
expedient –
the Court may make an order vesting the right to transfer or call for a transfer of
stock, or to receive the dividends or income of it, or to sue for or recover the thing
in action in any person as the Court may appoint.
(2) Where any such order is consequential on the appointment of a trustee,
the right shall be vested in the persons who, on the appointment, are the trustees.
(3) Where the person whose right is dealt with by any such order was
entitled jointly with another person, the right shall be vested in that last-mentioned
person either alone or jointly with any other person whom the Court may appoint.
(4) No such order shall be made vesting shares that are not fully paid up
in any person unless he applies for the order or consents to the making of the
order.
(5) In all cases, where a vesting order can be made under this section, the Court may, if it is more convenient, appoint some proper person to make or join in making the transfer; and without restricting the powers of the Court under this subsection it is hereby declared that the person appointed to make or join in making a transfer of stock may be some proper officer of the bank or company or society or association in whose books the stock is to be transferred.
(6) The person in whom the right to transfer or call for the transfer of any stock is vested by an order of the Court under this Act may transfer the stock to himself or any other person under the order, and all banks, societies, associations, companies, and persons shall obey every order under this section under its tenor. (7) After notice in writing of an order made under this section it shall not
be lawful for any bank, society, association, company, or person to transfer any
stock to which the order relates or to pay any dividends on it except under the
order.
(8) The Court may make declarations and give directions concerning the manner in which the right to transfer any stock or thing in action vested under this Act is to be exercised.

Trustee Act 1956 1685

60 Vesting orders in respect of shares in ships and industrial property

The provisions of this Act as to vesting orders shall apply to shares in ships
registered in Niue and to any intellectual property rights, as if they were stock.

61 Vesting orders of charity property

The powers conferred by this Act as to vesting orders may be exercised for
vesting any interest in any land, stock, or thing in action in any trustee of a charity
or society over which the Court would have jurisdiction upon action duly
instituted, whether the appointment of the trustee was made by instrument under
a power or by the Court under its general or statutory jurisdiction.

62 Orders made upon certain allegations to be conclusive evidence

Where a vesting order is made as to any land under this Act or under any
other Act founded on an allegation of any of the following matters, namely –
(a) The personal incapacity of a trustee or mortgagee; or
(b) That a trustee or mortgagee or the personal representative of or
other person deriving title under a trustee or mortgagee is out of
the jurisdiction of the Court or cannot be found, or (being a
corporation) has ceased to carry on business or is in liquidation or
has been dissolved; or
(c) That it is uncertain which of 2 or more trustees, or which of 2 or
more persons interested in a mortgage, was the survivor; or
(d) That it is uncertain whether the last trustee or the personal
representative of or other person deriving title under a trustee or
mortgagee, or the last surviving person interested in a mortgage is
living or dead; or
(e) That any trustee or mortgagee has died intestate without leaving a
person beneficially interested under the intestacy or has died and
it is not known who is his personal representative or the person
interested –
the fact that the order has been so made shall be conclusive evidence of the matter
so alleged in any Court upon any question as to the validity of the order; but this
section shall not prevent the Court from directing a reconveyance or surrender or
the payment of costs occasioned by any such order if improperly obtained.

of trust

(1) Subject to any contrary intention expressed in the instrument (if any)
creating the trust, where in the opinion of the Court any sale, lease, mortgage,
surrender, release, or other disposition, or any purchase, investment, acquisition,
retention, expenditure, or other transaction is expedient in the management or
administration of any property vested in a trustee, or would be in the best interests
of the persons beneficially interested under the trust, but it is inexpedient or difficult
or impracticable to effect the same without the assistance of the Court, or the
same cannot be effected by reason of the absence of any power for that purpose
vested in the trustee by the trust instrument (if any) or by law, the Court may by
order confer upon the trustee, either generally or in any particular instance, the
necessary power for the purpose, on such terms, and subject to such provisions
and conditions (if any) as the Court may think fit, and may direct in what manner
1686 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
any money authorised to be expended, and the costs of any transaction, are to be paid or borne, and as to the incidence of it between capital and income.
(2) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the instrument (if any) creating the trust, the Court, in proceedings in which all trustees and persons who are or may be interested are parties or are represented or consent to the order, may make such an order and may give such directions as it thinks fit to the trustee in respect of the exercise of any power conferred by the order.
(3) (a) The Court may rescind or vary any order made under this section, or may make any new or further order;
(b) No such rescission or variation of any order shall affect any act or thing done in reliance on the order before the person doing the act or thing became aware of the application to the Court to rescind or vary the order.
(4) An application to the Court under this section may be made by the trustees, or by any of them, or by any person beneficially interested under the trust.

64A Powers of Court to authorise variations

(1) Without limiting any other powers of the Court, it is hereby declared
that where any property is held on trusts arising under any will, settlement, or
other disposition, or on the intestacy or partial intestacy of any person, or under
any order of the Court, the Court may by order approve on behalf of –
(a) Any person having, directly or indirectly, an interest, whether vested
or contingent, under the trusts who by reason of infancy or other
incapacity is incapable of assenting; or
(b) Any person (whether ascertained or not) who may become entitled,
directly or indirectly, to an interest under the trusts as being at a
future date or on the happening of a future event a person of any
specified description or a member of any specified class of persons,
so however that this paragraph shall not include any person who
would be of that description, or a member of that class, as the case
may be, if the said date had fallen or the said event had happened
at the date of the application to the Court; or
(c) Any unborn or unknown person; or
(d) Any person in respect of any discretionary interest of his under
protective trusts where the interest of the principal beneficiary has
not failed or determined –
any arrangement (by whomsoever proposed, and whether or not there is any other
person beneficially interested who is capable of assenting to it) varying or revoking
all or any of the trusts, or enlarging the powers of the trustees of managing or
administering any of the property subject to the trusts:
Provided that, except by virtue of paragraph (d), the Court shall not approve an
arrangement on behalf of any person if the arrangement is to his detriment; and
in determining whether any such arrangement is to the detriment of any person
the Court may have regard to all benefits which may accrue to him directly or
indirectly in consequence of the arrangement, including the welfare and honour
of the family to which he belongs:
Provided also that this subsection shall not apply to any trust affecting property
settled by any Act other than the Administration Act 1969.
(2) Any rearrangement approved by the Court under subsection (1) shall
be binding on all persons on whose behalf it is so approved, and thereafter the
trusts as so rearranged shall take effect accordingly.

Trustee Act 1956 1687

(3) In this section –
“discretionary interest” means an interest arising under the trust specified
in section 42 (1)(b) or any like trust;
“principal beneficiary” has the same meaning as in section 42(1);
“protective trusts” means the trusts specified in section 42 (1) (a) or (b) or
any like trusts.

65 [Repealed]

66 Right of trustee to apply to Court for directions

(1) Any trustee may apply to the Court for directions concerning any
property subject to a trust, or respecting the management or administration of
any such property, or respecting the exercise of any power or discretion vested in
the trustee.
(2) Every such application shall be served upon, and the hearing may be
attended by, all persons interested in the application or such of them as the Court
thinks expedient.

67 Persons entitled to apply to Court

(1) An order under this Act for the appointment of a new trustee or
concerning any property subject to a trust may be made on the application of any
person beneficially interested in the property, whether under disability or not, or
on the application of any person duly appointed trustee of it or intended to be so
appointed.
(2) An order under this Act concerning any interest in any property subject
to a mortgage may be made on the application of any person beneficially interested
in the property, whether under disability or not, or of any person interested in the
money secured by the mortgage.

68 Applications to Court to review acts and decisions of trustee

(1) Any person who is beneficially interested in any trust property, and
who is aggrieved by any act or omission or decision of a trustee in the exercise of
any power conferred by this Act, or who has reasonable grounds to anticipate any
such act or omission or decision of a trustee by which he will be aggrieved, may
apply to the Court to review the act or omission or decision or to give directions in
respect of the anticipated act or omission or decision; and the Court may require
the trustee to appear before it, and to substantiate and uphold the grounds of the
act or omission or decision that is being reviewed, and may make such order in
the premises as the circumstances of the case may require:
Provided that no such order shall –
(a) Disturb any distribution of the trust property made without breach
of trust before the trustee became aware of the making of the
application to the Court;
(b) Affect any right acquired by any person in goods faith and for
valuable consideration.
(2) Where any such application is made, the Court may –
(a) If any question of fact is involved, direct how the question shall be
determined;
(b) If the Court is being asked to make an order that may prejudicially
affect the rights of any person who is not a party to the proceedings,
direct that any such person shall be made a party to the proceedings.
1688 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

69 Protection of trustee while acting under direction of Court

(1) Any trustee acting under any direction of the Court shall be deemed,
so far as regards his own responsibility, to have discharged his duty as such trustee
in the subject-matter of the direction, notwithstanding that the order giving the
direction is subsequently invalidated, overruled, set aside, or otherwise rendered
of no effect.
(2) This section shall not extend to indemnify any trustee in respect of any
act done under any such direction if he has bee guilty of any fraud or wilful
concealment or misrepresentation in obtaining the direction or inacquiescing in
the Court making the order giving the direction.

70 Powers of Court to give judgment in absence of a trustee

Where in any proceedings the Court is satisfied that diligent search has
been made for any person who, in the character of trustee, is made a defendant in
any action, to serve him with a process of the Court, and that he cannot be found,
the Court may hear and determine the proceedings and give judgment against
that person in his character of a trustee as if he had been duly served, or had
entered an appearance in the action, and had also appeared by his counsel and
solicitor at the hearing, but without prejudice to any interest he may have in the
matters in question in the proceedings in any other character.

71 Power of Court to charge costs

The Court may order the costs and expenses of and incidental to any
application for any order under this Act, or of and incidental to any such order, or
any conveyance or assignment in pursuance of it, to be raised and paid out of the
property in respect whereof the same is made, or out of the income thereof, or to
be borne and paid in such manner and by such persons as to the Court may seem
just.

72 Commission

(1) The Court may, out of the property subject to any trust, allow to any
person who is or has been a trustee thereof or to that person’s personal
representative such commission or percentage for that person’s services as is just
and reasonable.
(1A) In considering under subsection (1) what commission or percentage
is just and reasonable the Court shall have regard to the following circumstances,
namely –
(a) The total amount that has already been paid to any trustee of the trust, whether under the trust instrument or to any earlier order of the Court or to any agreement or otherwise;
(b) The amount and difficulty of the services rendered by the trustee;
(c) The liabilities to which the trustee is or has been exposed, and the
responsibilities imposed o him;
(d) The skill and success of the trustee in administering the trust;
(e) The value of the trust property;
(f) The time and services reasonably required of the trustee;
(g) Whether any commission or percentage that might otherwise have
been allowed should be refused or reduced by reason of delays in
the administration of the trust that were occasioned, or that could
reasonably have been prevented, by the trustee; and
(h) All other circumstances that the Court considers relevant.

Trustee Act 1956 1689

(2) The Court may make any such allowance at any time, before or during the administration of the trust, or on the termination of the trust, and may, subject to such terms and conditions as the Court thinks fit, make any such allowance in respect of services to be rendered by the trustee during any specified period subsequent to the date of the order.
(3) Where the Court allows a commission or percentage under this section
in any case in which 2 or more persons are or have been the trustees, whether
acting at the same time or at different times, the amount so allowed shall be
apportioned among the trustees as they mutually agree; and if there is no such
agreement the Court may, apportion the total amount allowed among the trustees
in such manner as it thinks fit, and, in particular, may divide the amount in unequal
shares or may make the allowance to one or more of the trustees to the exclusion
of the other or others.

73 Power to relieve trustee from personal liability

If it appears to the Court that a trustee, whether appointed by the Court or
otherwise, is or may be personally liable for any breach of trust, whether the
transaction alleged to be a breach of trust occurred before or after the
commencement of this Act, but has acted honestly and reasonably, and ought
fairly to be excused for the breach of trust and for omitting to obtain the directions
of the Court in the matter in which he committed the breach, then the Court may
relieve him either wholly or partly from personal liability for the same.

74 Power to make beneficiary indemnify for breach of trust

Where a trustee commits a breach of trust at the instigation or request or
with the consent in writing of a beneficiary, the Court may, and notwithstanding
that the beneficiary may be a married woman restrained from anticipation, make
such order as to the Court seems just for impounding all or any part of the interest
of the beneficiary in the trust estate by way of indemnity to the trustee or persons
claiming through him.

75 Barring of claims

(1) Where a trustee desires to reject a claim that has been made, or that he
has reason to believe may be made –
(a) To or against the estate or property that he is administering; or
(b) Against the trustee personally by reason of his being under any
liability in respect of which he is entitled to reimburse himself out
of the estate or property that he is administering –
the trustee may serve upon the claimant or the person who may become a claimant
as aforesaid a notice calling upon him, within a period of 3 months from the date
of service of the notice, to take legal proceedings to enforce the claim and also to
prosecute the proceedings with all due diligence.
(2) At the expiration of that period the trustee may apply to the Court for
an order under subsection (3), and shall serve a copy of the application on the
person concerned.
(3) If on the hearing of that application that person does not satisfy the
Court that he has commenced the proceedings and is prosecuting them with all
due diligence, the Court may make an order –
(a) Extending the period, or barring the claim, or enabling the trust
property to be dealt with without regard to the claim; and
(b) Imposing such conditions and giving such directions, including a
direction as to the payment of the costs of or incidental to the
application, as to the Court seems just.
1690

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(3A) Where a trustee has served any such notices in respect of claims on
2 or more persons and the period specified in each of the said notices has expired,
he may, if he thinks fit, apply for an order in respect of the claims of those persons
in a single application, and the Court may on that application make an order
accordingly.
(4) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(5) [Repealed]
(6) On an application by a trustee under this section, the persons
beneficially entitled to the estate or property need not be made parties to the
proceedings, and no order made by the Court on the application shall prejudice
their right to contest the claim of the trustee to be entitled to indemnify himself
out of the estate or property that he is administering if they have not been parties
to the proceedings in which the order was made.

76 Distribution of shares of missing beneficiaries

(1) Where any property is held by a trustee and the property or any part of
it cannot be distributed because the trustee does not know whether any person who is or may be entitled to it is or at any material date was in existence, or whether all of any of the persons who are members of any class who are or may be entitled to it are or at any material date were in existence, or because the trustee does not know whether any such person is alive or dead or where he is, the trustee may publish such advertisements (whether in Niue or elsewhere) as are appropriate in the circumstances calling upon every such person and every person claiming through any such person to send in his claim within a time to be specified in the advertisements, not being less than 2 months in any case from the date on which the advertisement is published. Where the trustee is in doubt as to what advertisements should be published under this subsection, he may apply to the Court for directions in that regard.
(2) (a) Where the trustee has received (whether as a result of the advertise–
ments or not) any claim to be a person to whom any such
advertisement relates, or any notice that any person may claim to
be such a person but the trustee is not satisfied that the claim is or
would be valid, the trustee may serve upon the claimant or the
person of whom the trustee has notice as aforesaid, a notice calling
upon him, within a period of 3 months from the date of service of
the notice, to take legal proceedings to enforce the claim, if he wishes
to pursue it, and to prosecute the proceedings with all due diligence;
and advising him that, if he fails to do so, his claim may be
disregarded and application may be made to the Court without
further notice for an order authorising the distribution of the
property.
(b) Nothing in this subsection shall make it necessary for the trustee to
serve such a notice on any such person; and the Court may make
an order under this section, whether or not such a notice has been
served on any such person, if it is satisfied that the information
supplied to the trustee by that person or otherwise in the possession
of the trustee indicates either that the person is not one of the persons
specified in the advertisements or that he is not likely to be one of
those persons.
(3) Upon proof by affidavit of the circumstances, and of the inquiries that
have been made, and of the results of the inquiries and advertisements, and of the
claims of which the trustee has received notice, and of the notices that the trustee

Trustee Act 1956 1691

has given to claimants under subsection (2), and of the action (if any) which the claimants have taken to enforce their claims, the Court may order that the trustee may distribute the property or part of it, subject to such conditions as the Court may impose –
(a) As if every person and every member of any class of persons specified in the order (being all or any of the persons specified in the advertisements) is not in existence or never existed or has died before a date or event specified in the order; and
(b) Where as a consequence of the order it is not possible or practicable
to determine whether or not any condition or requirement affecting
a beneficial interest in the property or any part of it has been
complied with or fulfilled, as if that condition or requirement had
or had not been complied with or fulfilled (as the Court may
determine).
(4) In making any order under subsection (3), the Court may –
(a) Disregard (without express reference to it in the order) the claims
of any persons who do not appear to the Court to be, or to be likely
to be, any of the persons specified in the advertisements;
(b) Disregard (without express reference to it in the order) the claim of
any person to whom the trustee has given notice under subsection
(2) and who has failed to take legal proceedings to enforce the claim
or to prosecute any such proceedings with all due diligence;
(c) Exclude from the operation of the order any person to whom the
trustee has not given notice under subsection (2) and who in the
opinion of the Court may be one of the persons specified in the
advertisements, or any person whom the Court considers should
for any reason be excluded from the operation of the order;
(d) Provide that the order shall not be acted on for such period or except
on such conditions as may be specified in the order or that the effect
of the order shall during a period so specified be advertised in such
manner and form as may be specified in the order, or that the order
be served upon such person or persons as are specified in it; and in
the event of the Court exercising the jurisdiction conferred by this
paragraph it may in the order direct that the same shall be of no
effect in respect of any person specified in it in the event of that
person instituting proceedings in Niue to enforce his claim and
serving the proceedings upon the trustee within such period as is
specified in the order.
(5) Any such order may be made notwithstanding that there has not been
strict compliance with any directions as to advertisements previously given by
the Court, or that an error has been made in any advertisement (whether or not
any directions have previously been given by the Court) if the Court considers
that the error would not be likely to have prejudiced or misled the persons to
whom the advertisement relates.
(6) (a) Where the Court makes an order under this section that the trustee
may distribute any property or part of it as if every person and
every member of any class of persons specified in the order (not
being a person expressly excluded from the operation of the order)
is not in existence or never existed or has died before a date or
event specified in the order, and the trustee distributes under the
order, the trustee shall be exonerated from any further liability to
any such person or to any member of any such class.
1692

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(b) Nothing in this subsection shall prejudice any remedy which any person may have against any person other than the trustee, including any right which he may have to follow the property and any money or property into which it is converted.
(7) The Court may make one or more orders under this section in respect of the same property.
(8) Any order made under this section may direct how the costs of the order and of advertising under or for the purposes of the order shall be borne.
(9) It shall not be necessary to serve notice of an application for an order
under this section upon any person, unless the Court otherwise orders.
(10) Nothing in this section shall prejudice the right of the trustee to
distribute under any other law or statutory provision or prejudice the protection
thereby afforded when he makes distribution under any such law or provision.

76A Service of notices under sections 75 and 76

(1) Any notice, application, or order that is to be served under section 75
or section 76 or under any order made under section 76, may be served –
(a) Either by delivering it to the person for whom it is intended or by
sending it by post in a registered letter addressed to that person at
his usual or last known place of abode or business; or
(b) In such other manner as may be directed by an order of the Court.
(2) Where a notice is sent by post as aforesaid it shall be deemed to be
served at the time at which the letter would have been delivered in the ordinary
course of post.

Payment to Crown

77 Payment by trustees to Crown

(1) (a) Trustees, or the majority of trustees, having in their hands or under
their control money or securities belonging to a trust, may, on filing
in the Court nearest to which they or the majority of them reside an
affidavit describing the instrument creating the trust and giving
particulars of the persons beneficially entitled under the trust to
the best of their knowledge and belief, and on serving a copy of the
affidavit on the Financial Secretary, pay the money or transfer the
securities (if they can legally be so transferred) to the Crown in the
matter of the particular trust, which shall be described in the
affidavit by the names of the parties as accurately as may be for the
purpose of distinguishing it.
(b) All money and securities so paid or transferred shall be administered
in the Treasury.
(c) All such money and all money derived from securities which have
been transferred to or vested in the Crown under this section shall
be credited by the Financial Secretary to a deposit account
established under the Public Revenues Act to be dealt with as
hereafter provided in this Act.
(2) The receipt of the Financial Secretary shall be a sufficient discharge to
the trustees for the money or securities paid or transferred to the Crown under this section.
(3) Where money or securities are vested in any persons as trustees, and the majority are desirous of paying or transferring the same to the Crown as aforesaid, but the concurrence of the other or others cannot be obtained, the Court may order the payment or transfer to the Crown to be made by the majority without the concurrence of the other or others.

Trustee Act 1956 1693

(4) Where any such money or securities are deposited with any banker, broker or other depositary, the Court may order payment or delivery of the money or securities to the majority of the trustees for the purpose of payment or transfer to the Crown.
(5) Every transfer, payment, and deliver made under any such order shall be valid and take effect as if the same had been made on the authority or by the act of all the persons entitled to the money and securities so transferred, paid, or delivered.
(6) The Financial Secretary may at any time sell any securities held by the
Crown under this section.
(7) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(8) Where any trustee has obtained or is seeking a discharge in respect of
any money or securities under this section or has obtained such a discharge under
the corresponding provisions of any former section, the Financial Secretary may
at any time require that trustee to give such information in his possession or control
as he may require in relation to the persons beneficially entitled to the money or
securities, including information as to the steps taken to trace those persons; and
if any person refuses or wilfully neglects to give any such information that is in
his possession or control when so required, or wilfully gives any false information
in answer to any such requisition, he commits an offence and shall be liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.

78 Disposal of funds paid to Crown

(1) At the end of each financial year the Financial Secretary shall publish
in the Gazette a statement of all money and securities then held by the Crown under section 77, being –
(a) Money which has not previously been credited to the Niue
Government Account under subsection (4);
(b) Securities which were transferred to the Crown within the
immediately preceding 6 years or which were transferred or
deposited into or in the name of any Registrar under section 67 of
the Trustee Act 1908 within the immediately preceding 6 years.
(2) Every statement so published in the Gazette shall contain sufficient
particulars to show the matters in which the money and securities are held by the
Crown and the amount held in respect of each matter.
(3) (a) All money and securities for the time being held by the Crown under
section 77 (whether or not they are held in the Niue Government
Account shall be so held to attend the order of the Court.
(b) Any such money or securities may be paid or transferred by the
Financial Secretary to the person entitled to it upon his establishing
a claim to it or may be paid or transferred to the person from whom
they were received to be held by him as trustee if that person so
requests.
(c) All costs and expenses reasonably incurred by the Crown or the
Financial Secretary in connection with any such money or securities
may be deducted out of the money or securities or out of any other
money and securities which are for the time being held by the Crown
and are subject to the same trusts.
(4) The Financial Secretary shall transfer to the Niue Government Account
all money held under section 77, being money which was –
(a) Paid to the Crown more than 6 years previously; or
(b) Derived from securities which were transferred to the Crown, or
transferred or deposited in the name of any Registrar, more than 6
years previously.
1694 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(5) Any money previously transferred to the Niue Government Account under subsection (4) which is paid or required to be paid under subsection (3) may be paid out of the Niue Government Account without further appropriation than this subsection.
(6) (a) Under no circumstances shall the liability of the Crown or the Financial Secretary in respect of any securities which are transferred to or vested in the Crown under section 77 exceed the value of those securities and of any other securities and money which are held by the Crown and subject to the same trusts at the time when demand is made for satisfaction of the liability.
(b) If the said securities and money are insufficient to meet any such liability, the claimant shall, in respect of any unpaid balance of the liability, have the same rights and remedies against the person beneficially entitled to the securities in respect of which the liability arose as he would if those securities were transferred to that person.
(7) Neither the Crown nor the Financial Secretary shall have the duties or liabilities of a trustee in respect of any money or securities for the time being held by the Crown under section 77 (whether in the Niue Government Account or not); and no interest shall be payable by the Crown or the Financial Secretary in respect of any money so held.
(8) Where any money or securities paid or transferred to any claimant
under this section are afterwards claimed by any other person, the Crown and the
Financial Secretary shall not be responsible for the payment or transfer of it but
that person shall have recourse against the claimant to whom the money was
paid or the securities were transferred.

79 Orders in respect of funds paid to Crown

(1) (a) Upon application made ex parte by such person or persons as are
competent or necessary in that behalf, the Court may make such
order as it thinks fit in respect of any money or securities for the
time being held by the Crown under section 77 (whether in the
Niue Government Account or not), and for the payment, transfer,
and administration of it.
(b) The Court may direct service of the application on such persons as
it thinks fit.
(2) Every such order shall have the same authority and effect and shall be
subject to rehearing and appeal in the same manner as if it had been made in any
action regularly instituted in the Court; and if it appears that any such money or
securities cannot be safely distributed without the institution of one or more actions,
the Court may direct any such action to be instituted.
PART 6
GENERAL PROVISIONS

80 Indemnity to banks and others

This Act, and every order purporting to be made under this Act, shall be a
complete indemnity to all banks, companies, societies, associations, and persons
for any acts done pursuant to it, and it shall not be necessary for any bank, company,
society, association, or person to inquire concerning the propriety of the order, or
whether the Court had jurisdiction to make it.

Trustee Act 1956 1695

81 Operation on bank account of trustees

(1) Where there are more trustees than one, and the trustees, by writing
under their hands communicated to a bank at which their account is kept, arrange
that the account may be operated upon by cheques or drafts signed by one or
more of them, or by one of them and a delegate or delegates named in the writing
of another or others of them, the bank shall be entitled to honour and pay the
cheques or drafts as if they had been signed by all the trustees, until the bank
receives notice in writing of the revocation, by death or otherwise, of the
arrangement.
(2) Nothing in this section or in any rule of law shall prevent trustees from
opening a bank account named as an imprest account and from authorising any
one or more of their number or any other person or persons to operate upon the
imprest account.

82 [Repealed]

83 Special rules as to apportionment

(1) For the purposes of this section –
(a) The term “fixed-income asset” means an asset coming within any
of the following classes –
(i) The securities mentioned in section 4 (1) (a), (c), (d), (e), (f), (g)
and (i);
(ii) Debentures, bonds, and stock (other than shares) in which the
trustee is authorised to invest trust money;
(iii) Any other asset bearing interest or carrying the right to a
dividend if the interest or dividend is payable at a fixed rate
and if the interest or dividend has been paid regularly in respect
of the asset for at least 5 years before the material date and if
the trustee has no reason to believe that the interest or dividend
in respect of the period to which the apportionment relates will
not be paid reasonably promptly after the same falls due;
(b) The term “shares” means share or stock of any company, whether
incorporated in or outside Niue except any such shares or stock
which constitutes a fixed-income asset under paragraph (a) (iii);
(c) An appropriation of shares (whether under the power conferred
by section 15 (1) (j) or otherwise) shall be deemed to be a transfer of
those shares to which subsection (4) applies.
(2) Where any payment received by a trustee in respect of a sale of any
fixed-income asset is or includes payment for the right to receive income accrued
from that asset at the time of sale, though the income may not then be due, the
amount of the accrued income shall, for the purposes of the trust, be deemed to
have been received as income in respect of the period during which it so accrued.
(3) Where any payment made by a trustee in respect of a purchase of any
fixed-income asset is or includes payment for the right to receive any income
accrued from that asset at the time of the purchase, though the income may not
then be due, the amount of the accrued income when received shall, for the
purposes of the trust, be deemed to have been received as purchase money repaid.
(4) Where a trustee transfers any shares (not being a fixed-income asset) to
the person entitled to it under the trust, then, unless the trustee in his absolute
discretion having regard to all the circumstances of the case thinks that it is
equitable, practicable, and convenient to make an apportionment, there shall be
no apportionment of any dividends which have accrued at the date of transfer
1696 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
but have not then been declared, and no person who would have been beneficially interested in any such dividends if they had been declared and paid to the trustee shall have any claim in respect of it against the trustee or against the transferee of the shares.
(5) Where a trustee sells any shares that are not a fixed-income asset, no part of the proceeds of the sale shall, for the purposes of the trust, be deemed to have been paid for the right to receive dividends which have accrued in respect of the shares at the time of the sale, but have not then been declared, and there shall accordingly be no apportionment of the proceeds as between capital and income. (6) Where a trustee purchases any shares that are not a fixed-income asset,
no part of the purchase price shall, for the purposes of the trust, be deemed to be paid for the right to receive any dividends which have accrued in respect of the shares at the time of the purchase but have not then been declared, and there shall accordingly be no apportionment of the purchase price as between capital and income, nor shall any part of the dividends received by the trustee be deemed to have been received as purchase money repaid.
(7) Except as herein expressly provided, nothing in this section shall affect the rights and obligations of the trustee or of any other person in respect of apportionment of income on the sale or purchase of any asset or the transfer of it to any person beneficially entitled to it.
(8) Anything done by a trustee before the commencement of this section
which would have been authorised by this section if then in force shall be deemed
to have been authorised by this section.
(9) The provisions of this section shall apply if and so far only as a contrary
intention is not expressed in the instrument, if any, creating the trust, and shall
have effect subject to the terms of that instrument.

83A Examination of accounts of trust estates administered by trustee corporations

In the case of any trust estate administered by a trustee corporation, a solicitor or accountant authorised in writing by a beneficiary shall be entitled as of right to examine at any reasonable time the accounts of that estate, and for the purpose shall have access to the trustee corporation’s books and vouchers (but not the file) relating to that estate, and to the securities and documents of title held by the trustee corporation on account of that estate.

83B Audit of other trust estates

Subject to the provisions of any regulations made under this Act, and unless
the Court otherwise orders, the condition and accounts of any trust estate (being
an estate which is not being administered by a trustee corporation) shall, on an
application being made and notice of it being given in the prescribed manner by
or on behalf of any trustee or beneficiary in that estate, be investigated and audited
by such solicitor or such member of the New Zealand Society of Accountants as
may be agreed on between the applicant trustee and his co-trustees.

84 Costs and testamentary expenses to be payable out of capital of settled

residuary estate of deceased

(1) (a) Where, under the provisions of the will of a person dying after the
commencement of this Act (in this section referred to as the
deceased) any real or personal property included either by specific
or general description in a residuary gift is settled by way of
succession, no part of the income of that property shall be applicable

Trustee Act 1956 1697

in or towards the payment of the funeral, testamentary, and administration expenses, death duties, debts, legacies, and liabilities, or of the interest (if any) on it up to the date of the death of the deceased.
(b) This subsection shall not apply to any commission which is payable to the trustee in respect of any such income or to any testamentary or administration expenses which, apart from this subsection, would be payable wholly out of income.
(2) The income of the settled property shall be applicable in priority to any
other assets in payment of the interest (if any) accruing due on the funeral,
testamentary, and administration expenses, death duties, debts, legacies, and
liabilities after the date of the death of the deceased and up to the payment of it,
and the balance of that income shall be payable to the person for the time being
entitled to the income of the property.
(3) Where, after the death of the deceased, income of assets comprised in
the settled property which are ultimately applied in or towards payment of the
funeral, testamentary, and administration expenses, death duties, debts, legacies
and liabilities, arises pending that application, that income shall, for the purposes
of this section, be deemed income of the residual estate of the deceased.
(4) This section shall only affect the rights of beneficiaries under the will
as between themselves, and shall not affect the rights of creditors of the deceased
or limit any other powers of the trustee.
(5) The provisions of this section shall apply if and so far only as a contrary
intention is not expressed in the will, and shall have effect subject to the terms of
the will and of any Act as to charges on property of the deceased.
(6) Nothing in this section shall apply to any annuity which is payable out
of the estate of the deceased.

85 Application of income of settled property pending conversion

(1) Subject to this section, where under the will of any person any real or
personal property included (either by specific or general description) in a residuary
gift is settled by way of succession, then, notwithstanding that the property may
be of a wasting, speculative, or reversionary nature –
(a) Pending any sale, calling in, or conversion of the settled property,
the whole of the net income of property actually producing income
shall be applied as income and no part of it shall be appropriated to
capital; and
(b) On any such sale, calling in, or conversion, or on the falling in of
any reversionary property, no part of the proceeds of the sale, calling
in, conversion, or falling in, shall be applied as past income.
(2) This section shall apply only in respect of the wills of persons who die
after the date of the commencement of this Act.
(3) This section shall apply if and so far only as a contrary intention is not
expressed in the will of the deceased, and shall have effect subject to the terms of
that will.

86 Fees and commission deemed a testamentary expense

The fees, commission, remuneration and other charges payable to a trustee
in respect of the administration of the estate of a deceased person shall be deemed
to be testamentary expenses.
1698 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

87 Costs of inquiring regarding beneficiaries

The costs, expenses and charges of the trustee of any property in respect of
any inquiries made by him to ascertain the existence and identity of any person or
persons entitled to any legacy, money, or distributive share in the property or
otherwise incurred in relation to it shall be borne by and paid out of the legacy,
money, or distributive share of the person or persons in respect of whom the
inquiries were made.

88 Life tenant to have powers of a trustee in certain cases

(1) In any case where there is no trustee of any land, but the land is for the
time being lawfully vested in any person entitled to the possession of it or to the
receipt of the rents and profits from it for an estate for life, or for a term of years
determinable with his life, or for any greater estate, that person may exercise all
the powers conferred on a trustee by this Act, and the Court may confer on that
person all the powers which it could confer on a trustee under this Act; and
anything done by any such person in exercise of any such power shall have the
same force and effect as if it had been done by a trustee.
(2) Nothing in this section shall authorise any such person to sell any such
land, or to raise any capital money by a mortgage of it or other dealing with it,
unless the money paid on the sale or the capital money so raised is paid to a
trustee who is duly appointed and entitled to receive it.

89 [Spent]

90 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations as it thinks fit for the purposes of this
Act.
1699

TRUSTEE COMPANIES ACT 1995

[EDITORIAL NOTE: This Act is not reproduced. With the repeal of the off-shore business legislation by the Companies Act 2006 this statute has little relevance and is listed for repeal.]

1700 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1701

TRUSTS ACT 1994

1994/182 – 28 March 1994

THE SETTLOR, BENEFICIARIES AND PURPOSES OF A

TRUST

10 Who may be the settlor of a trust

11 Beneficiaries of a trust

12 Nature of a beneficial interest

13 Protective or spendthrift trusts

14 Letters or memorandum of wishes

15 Definition of charitable purposes

16 Trusts for non-charitable purposes

PART 3

PROTECTORS AND TRUSTEES

17 The protector of a trust

18 Who may be the trustee of a trust

19 The number of trustees

20 Appointment of new or additional trustees

21 Appointment of trustee resident in Niue

22 Renunciation of trusteeship

23 Resignation or removal of trustees

24 Nature of trustees’ and protectors’ interests

25 Corporate trustee may act by resolution

26 Trustees of more than one trust

27 Dealings by trustees with third parties

PART 4

DUTIES AND POWERS OF TRUSTEES

28 General duties of trustees

29 Duty to supply information and duty of

confidentiality

30 Duty of trustees to act together

31 Duty to act impartially

32 General powers of trustees

33 Powers of investment

34 Implied powers of trustees

35 Delegation by trustees

36 Reimbursement of expenses

37 Payment of trustees

38 Power to appropriate

39 Power and duty of maintenance

40 Power of advancement

41 Accumulation and maintenance

settlements

42 Receipts of parents or guardians

43 Power of appointment

44 Power of revocation or variation

PART 5

TERMINATION OR FAILURE OF TRUSTS

45 Failure or lapse of interest

46 Application of property held on charitable

trust

47 Termination of trusts

48 Termination by beneficiaries

PART 6

VARIATION OF TRUSTS

49 Variation of trusts

50 Approval of particular transaction

PART 7

BREACH OF TRUST

51 Liability for breach of trust

52 Constructive trusts

53 Tracing trust property

54 Beneficiary may relieve or indemnify a

trustee

55 Power to relieve trustees from personal

liability

56 Power to make beneficiaries indemnify

57 Limitation and prescription

1702 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

PART 8 63 Provisions of variant types of trust

POWERS OF THE COURT

58 Jurisdiction of the Court PART 10

59 General powers of the Court REGISTRATION OF TRUSTS AND EXEMPT TRUSTS

60 Applications for directions 64 Facility to register trusts

61 Payments of costs 65 Exemption from taxes and duties

PART 9 SCHEDULES VARIANT TYPES OF TRUST

62 Variant types of trust

To make provision for the law relating to trusts and trustees and related matters

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
1994.
(1) This Act is the Trusts Act 1994.
(2) This Act shall apply only to trusts created on or after the 28 March

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act –
“bankrupt”, in relation to a corporation, includes a corporation which is
insolvent;
“beneficiary” means a person entitled to benefit under a trust, or in whose
favour a power to distribute trust property may be exercised;
“breach of trust” means a breach of any duty imposed on a trustee by this
Act or by the terms of the trust;
“corporate trustee” means a trustee which is a corporation;
“corporation” means a body corporate wherever incorporated;
“family” in relation to an individual means his father and mother, his
spouse, the father and mother of his spouse, his brothers and sisters
and the brothers and sisters of his spouse, his children and remoter
issue and the spouses of such children and issue;
“functions” includes rights, powers, discretions, obligations, liabilities and
duties;
“he”, “him”, and “his”, “her”, “she”, in relation to a corporation include
“it” and “its”;
“insolvency” includes the making of an administration order, the
appointment of a receiver and the bankruptcy of any person;
“insurance” incudes assurance;
:interest”, in relation to a beneficiary, means interest of the beneficiary under
a trust;
“Minister” means the Minister of Justice;
“minor” means a person who has not attained full age under the law of his
domicile;
“ordinarily resident” has the same meaning as in article 17 of the
Constitution;
“personal representative” means the executor or administrator of the estate
of a deceased person;

Trusts Act 1994 1703

“profit” includes gain or advantage; “property” –
(a) means property of any description, wherever situated, including any share in it,
(b) In relation to rights and interests, includes rights and interests whether vested, contingent, defeasible or future;
“provisions of this Act” includes the provisions of any order under this
Act;
“settlor” means a person who provides the trust property or makes a
testamentary disposition on trust or to a trust;
“terms of a trust” means the written or oral terms of a trust, and any other
applicable under its proper law;
“trust” includes –
(a) the trust property; and
(b) the functions, interests and relationships under a trust;
“trustee” has the meaning given by section 3, and includes a corporate
trustee;
“trust property” means property held on trust;
“unit trust” means a trust established for the purpose, or having the effect,
of providing, for persons having funds available for investment,
facilities for the participation by them as beneficiaries under the trust
in any profits or income arising from the acquisition, holding,
management or disposal of property.
(2) For the purposes of this Act, a corporation is resident in the place in
which it has its registered office.

3 Definition of trust

A trust exists where a person (known as “a trustee”) holds or has vested in
him, or is deemed to hold or have vested in him, property which does not form, or
which has ceased to form, part of his own estate
(a) For the benefit of a beneficiary, whether or not yet ascertained or in
existence; or
(b) For any valid charitable or non-charitable purpose which is not for
the benefit only of the trustee; or
(c) For such benefit as is mentioned in paragraph (a) and also for any
such purpose as is mentioned in paragraph (b).

4 Validity of trusts

Subject to this Act, a trust is valid and enforceable in Niue.

5 Proper law of trusts

(1) Subject to subsection (4) below, the proper law of a trust shall be –
(a) The law expressed by the terms of the trust or intended by the settlor
to be the proper law;
(b) If no such law is expressed or intended, the law with which the
trust has its closest connection at the time of its creation; or
(c) If the law expressed by the terms of the trust or intended by the
settlor to be the proper law, or the law with which the trust has its
closest connection at the time of its creation, does not provide for
trusts or the category of trusts involved, then the proper law of the
trust shall be the law of Niue.
1704 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) In ascertaining the law with which a trust has its closest connection, reference shall be made in particular to –
(a) The place of administration of the trust designated by the settlor; (b) The situs of the assets of the trust;
(c) The place of residence or business of the trustee;
(d) The objects of the trust and the places where they are to be fulfilled.
(3) The terms of a trust may provide for a severable aspect of the trust
(particularly the administration of the trust) to be governed by a different law
from the proper law of the trust.
(4) The terms of a trust may provide for the proper law of the trust or the
law governing a severable aspect of the trust to be changed from the law of one
jurisdiction to the law of another jurisdiction.
(5) Where the proper law of a trust or the law governing a severable aspect
of a trust is changed from the law of another jurisdiction (here called “the old
law”) to the law of Niue no provision of the old law shall operate so as to render
the trust void, invalid, or unlawful or to render void, invalid or unlawful any
functions conferred on the trustee under the law of Niue.
(6) Where the proper law of a trust or the laws governing a severable aspect
of a trust is changed from the law of Niue to the law of another jurisdiction (here
called “the old law”) no provision of the law of Niue shall operate so as to render
the trust void, invalid or unlawful or to render void, invalid or unlawful any
functions conferred on the trustee under the new law.
(7) This Act shall not apply and the Trustee Act 1956 shall continue to apply
to a trust created on or after 28 March 1994 where –
(a) The trust substantially provides benefits for an individual ordinarily
resident in or domiciled in Niue; or
(b) The trust substantially provides benefits for any corporation or other
entity owned by an individual ordinarily resident or domiciled in
Niue,

6 Creation of a trust

(1) A trust other than a unit trust may be created by an instrument in writing
(including a will or codicil), by conduct, by operation of law, or in any other manner
whatsoever.
(2) A unit trust may be created only by an instrument in writing.
(3) No formalities or technical expresses are required for the creation of a
trust provided that the intention of the settlor to create a trust is clearly manifested.
(4) A trust (other than a trust by operation of law) respecting land situated
in Niue shall not be enforceable.

7 Maximum duration of a trust and of accumulation of income

(1) Subject to subsection (2), the maximum duration of a trust shall be 120
years from the date of its creation and a trust shall terminate on the 120th
anniversary of the date of its creation unless it is terminated sooner.
(2) Subsection (1) shall not apply to a trust established exclusively for a
charitable purpose or purposes.
(3) The rule of law known as the rule against perpetuities shall not apply
to any trust to which this section applies.
(4) The terms of a trust may direct or authorise the accumulation of all or
part of the income of the trust for a period not exceeding the maximum duration
of the trust.

Trusts Act 1994 1705

8 Validity of a trust

(1) Subject to this Act, a trust shall be valid and enforceable in accordance
with its terms.
(2) A trust shall be invalid and unenforceable –
(a) To the extent that –
(i) it purports to do anything contrary to the law of Niue; or
(ii) it purports to confer any right or power or impose any
obligation the exercise of which or the carrying out of which is
contrary to the law of Niue; or
(iii) it has no beneficiary identifiable or ascertainable (unless the
trust was created for a valid charitable or non-charitable
purpose);
(b) To the extent that the Court declares that –
(i) the trust was established by duress, fraud, mistake, undue
influence or misrepresentation; or
(ii) the trust is immoral or contrary to public policy; or
(iii) the terms of the trust are so uncertain that its performance is
rendered impossible (provided that a charitable purpose shall
be deemed always to be capable of performance); or
(iv) the settlor was, at the time of its creation, incapable under the
law in force in Niue of creating such a trust.
(3) Where a trust is created for 2 or more purposes of which some are lawful
and others are not, or where some of the terms of a trust are invalid and others are
not –
(a) If those purposes cannot be separated or the terms cannot be separated, the trust is invalid;
(b) If those purposes can be separated or the terms can be separated,
the Court may declare that the trust is valid as to the terms which
are valid and the purposes which are lawful.
(4) Where a trust is partially invalid the Court may declare what property
is to be held subject to the trust.
(5) Property provided by a settlor and as to which a trust is invalid shall,
subject to any order of the Court, be held by the trust for the settlor absolutely or,
if he is dead, as if it had formed part of his estate at his death.
(6) Where a trust is created under the law of Niue, the Court shall not vary
it or set it aside or recognise the validity of any claim against the trust property
under the law of another jurisdiction or the order of a court of another jurisdiction
in respect of –
(a) The personal and proprietary consequences of marriage or the
termination of marriage;
(b) Succession rights (whether testate or intestate) including the fixed
shares of spouses or relatives; or
(c) The claims of creditors in an insolvency.

9 Property which may be held on trust

(1) Any property may be held by or vested in a trustee upon trust.
(2) A trustee may accept from any person property to be held on trust.
(3) A trustee shall not be bound to accept property to be held on trust, but
where a trustee accepts property subject to the performance of an obligation the
trustee shall be deemed to have given to the obligee for good consideration an
undertaking to perform that obligation.
1706 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(4) Where a settlor declares a trust respecting property he does not own at the time of the declaration, then –
(a) The trust is incompletely constituted at the time of the declaration and no rights or duties arise thereunder, but
(b) If the settlor subsequently receives property which was the intended subject matter of the declaration of trust, the Court shall at the instance of the beneficiary or the trustee (and whether the beneficiary has given consideration for the declaration of trust or not) compel the settlor to transfer that property to the trustee or to hold that property on the terms of the trust.
PART 2
THE SETTLOR, BENEFICIARIES AND PURPOSES OF A TRUST

10 Who may be the settlor of a trust

(1) Any person who has under the law of Niue the capacity to own and
transfer property may be the settlor of a trust.
(2) The settlor may also be a trustee, a beneficiary or a protector of the
trust.

11 Beneficiaries of a trust

(1) A beneficiary shall be identifiable by name or ascertainable by reference
to a relationship of some person (whether or not living at the time of creation of
the trust) or otherwise by reference to a description or to a class.
(2) The terms of a trust may –
(a) Provide for the addition of a person as a beneficiary or the exclusion
of a beneficiary from benefit under the trust;
(b) Impose an obligation on a beneficiary as a condition of benefit under
the trust;
(3) Where a trust is in favour of a class of persons then, subject to the terms
of the trust –
(a) The class closes when it is no longer possible for any other person
to become a member of the class;
(b) A woman over the age of 60 years shall be deemed to be no longer
capable of bearing a child; and
(c) Where the interest of the class relates to income, and no member of
the class exists, the income shall be accumulated and retained until
a member of the class exits or the class closes.
(4) A beneficiary may –
(a) Disclaim his whole interest under a trust; or
(b) Subject to the terms of the trust, disclaim part of his interest under
a trust (whether or not he has received some benefit from his
interest);
(5) Subject to the terms of the trust, a disclaimer –
(a) Shall be in writing;
(b) May be temporary; and
(c) May, if the disclaimer so provides, be revoked in the manner and
under the circumstances specified therein.
(6) Where a beneficiary disclaims the whole or part of his interest under a
trust the like consequences shall apply under section 7(5) as if the trust were invalid
with respect to that interest or that part.

Trusts Act 1994 1707

12 Nature of a beneficial interest

(1) The interest of a beneficiary is personal property.
(2) Subject to the terms of the trust, the interest of a beneficiary may be
sold, pledged, charged, transferred or otherwise dealt with in any manner
whatsoever.

13 Protective or spendthrift trusts

(1) The terms of a trust may make the interest of a beneficiary –
(a) Subject to termination;
(b) Subject to restriction on alienation of or dealing in that interest or
any part of that interest; or
(c) Subject to diminution or termination in the event of the beneficiary
becoming insolvent or any of his property becoming liable to seizure
or sequestration for the benefit o his creditors and such a trust shall
be known as a protective or a spendthrift trust.
(2) Where any property is directed to be held on protective or spendthrift
trust for the benefit of a beneficiary, the trustee shall hold that property –
(a) In trust to pay the income to the beneficiary until the interest
terminates in accordance with the terms of the trust or a determining
event occurs; and
(b) If a determining event occurs, and while the interest of the
beneficiary continues, in trust to pay the income to such of the
following (and if more than one in such shares) as the trustee in his
absolute discretion shall appoint –
(i) the beneficiary and any spouse or child of the beneficiary; or
(ii) if there is no spouse or child of the beneficiary the beneficiary
and the persons who would be entitled to the estate of the
beneficiary if he had then died intestate and domiciled in Niue.
(3) In subsection (2) “determining event” means the occurrence of any event
or any act or omission on the part of the beneficiary (other than the giving of
consent to an advancement of trust property) which would result in the whole or
part of the income of the beneficiary from the trust becoming payable to any person
other than the beneficiary.
(4) Any rule of law or public policy which prevents a settlor from
establishing a protective or a spendthrift trust of which he is a beneficiary is hereby
abolished.

14 Letters or memoranda of wishes

(1) The settlor of a trust may give to the trustee a letter of his wishes or the
trustee may prepare a memorandum of the wishes of the settlor with regard to the
exercise of any functions conferred on the trustee by the terms of the trust.
(2) A beneficiary of a trust may give to the trustee a letter of his wishes or
the trustee may prepare a memorandum of the wishes of the beneficiary with
regard to the exercise of any functions conferred on the trustee by the terms of the
trust.
(3) Where a trust is in favour of a class of persons then a member of that class may give to the trustee a letter of his wishes or the trustee may prepare a memorandum of the wishes of that member with regard to the exercise of any functions conferred on the trustee by the terms of that trust.
(4) Where a letter of wishes or a memorandum of wishes is given to or
prepared by the trustee of a trust then –
1708 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(a) The trustee may have regard to the letter or memorandum in exercising any functions conferred upon him by the terms of the trust; but
(b) The trustees shall not be bound to have regard to that letter or memorandum and shall not be accountable in any way for his failure or refusal to have regard to that letter or memorandum.
(5) No fiduciary duty or obligation shall be imposed on a trustee merely by the giving to him of a letter of wishes or the preparation by him of a memorandum of wishes.

15 Definition of charitable purposes

(1) For the purposes of this Act, and subject to subsections (2) and (3), the
following purposes shall be regarded as charitable –
(a) The relief of poverty;
(b) The advancement of education;
(c) The advancement of religion;
(d) The protection of the environment;
(e) The advancement of human rights and fundamental freedoms;
(f) The advancement of amateur sport;
(g) Any other purposes which are beneficial to the community.
(2) A purpose shall not be regarded as charitable unless the fulfillment of
that purpose is for the benefit of the community or a substantial section of the
community having regard to the type and nature of the purpose.
(3) A purpose may be regarded as charitable whether it is to be carried out
in Niue or elsewhere and whether it is beneficial to the community in Niue or
elsewhere.

16 Trusts for non-charitable purposes

(1) A trust may be created for the purpose which is non-charitable provided
that –
(a) The purpose is specific, reasonable and capable of fulfillment;
(b) The purpose is not immoral, unlawful or contrary to public policy;
and
(c) The terms of the trust provide for the appointment of a protector
who is capable of enforcing the trust and for the appointment of a
successor to any protector.
(2) If Cabinet, on the advice of the Minister, has reason to believe that there
is no protector of a trust for a non-charitable purpose or the protector is unwilling or incapable of acting, it may appoint a person to be protector of the trust and such person shall from the date of appointment exercise the functions of protector of the trust.
PART 3
PROTECTORS AND TRUSTEES

17 The protector of a trust

(1) The terms of a trust may provide for the office of protector of the trust.
(2) The protector shall have the following powers –
(a) (Unless the terms of the trust shall otherwise provide) the power to
remove a trustee and to appoint a new or additional trustee;
(b) Such further powers as are conferred on the protector by the terms
of the trust or of this Act.
(3) The protector of a trust may also be a settlor, a trustee or a beneficiary
of the trust.

Trusts Act 1994 1709

(4) In the exercise of his office, the protector shall not be accounted or regarded as a trustee.
(5) Subject to the terms of the trust, in the exercise of his office a protector shall owe a fiduciary duty to the beneficiaries of the trust or to the purpose for which the trust is created.
(6) Where there is more than one protector of a trust then, subject to the
terms of the trust, any functions conferred on the protectors may be exercised if
more than one half of the protectors for the time being agree on its exercise.
(7) A protector who dissents from a decision of the majority of protectors
may require his dissent to be recorded in writing.

18 Who may be the trustee of a trust

(1) Any person who has under the law of Niue the capacity to own and
transfer property may be the trustee of a trust.
(2) The trustee may also be a settlor, a beneficiary or a protector of the
trust.

19 The number of trustees

(1) Unless the terms of the trust provide for a greater number, the minimum
of trustees shall be one.
(2) A trust shall not cease to be valid only on the ground that there is no
trustee or fewer than the number of trustees required by the terms of the trust.
(3) Where there is no trustee or fewer than the number of trustees required
by the terms of the trust, the necessary number of new or additional trustees shall
be appointed and until the minimum number is reached the surviving trustee (if
any) shall act only for the purpose of preserving the trust property.
(4) Except in the case of a trust established for a charitable purpose –
(a) The number of trustees shall be not more than 4; and
(b) If at any time there are more than 4 persons named as trustees, only
the first 4 persons so named shall be the trustees of the trust.

20 Appointment of new or additional trustees

(1) Where the terms of a trust contain no provision for the appointment of
a new or additional trustee, then –
(a) The protector (if any); or
(b) The trustees for the time being (but so that a trustee shall not be
required to join in the appointment of his replacement); or
(c) The last remaining trustee; or
(d) The personal representative or liquidator of the last remaining
trustee; or
(e) If there is no such person (or no such person willing to act) the
Court may appoint a new or additional trustee.
(2) Subject to the terms of the trust, a trustee appointed under this section
shall have the same functions and may act as if he had been originally appointed
a trustee.
(3) On the appointment of a new or additional trustee, anything requisite
for vesting the trust property in the trustees for the time being of the trust shall be
done.
1710 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

21 Appointment of trustee resident in Niue

(1) Where there is no trustee resident in Niue, a beneficiary may apply for
the appointment of a person, resident in Niue and nominated in the application,
as an additional trustee.
(2) The Court –
(a) If satisfied that notice of the application has been served on the
existing trustee;
(b) Having heard any representations; and
(c) Having ascertained that the person nominated is willing to act;
may appoint that person as an additional trustee.
(3) Notwithstanding section 19, the power contained in this section may
be exercised even if it results in there being more than 4 trustees for the time being
of the trust.
(4) The terms of a trust may expressly exclude the operation of subsections
(1) and (2).

22 Renunciation of trusteeship

(1) No person shall be obliged to accept appointment as a trustee, but a
person nominated as trustee who knowingly intermeddles with the trust property
shall be deemed to have accepted appointment as a trustee.
(2) A person who has not accepted and is not deemed to have accepted
appointment as a trustee of a trust may within a reasonable period of time after
becoming aware of this nomination as trustee –
(a) Disclaim his appointment by notice in writing to the other trustees
of such trust (if any); or
(b) If there are no such other trustees or such other trustees cannot be
contacted, apply to the Court for relief from his appointment and
the Court may make such order as it thinks fit.
(3) A person nominated as a trustee who does not act under subsection (2)
within a reasonable period of becoming aware of his nomination shall be deemed
to have accepted appointment as a trustee.

23 Resignation or removal of trustees

(1) A trustee other than a sole trustee may resign by notice in writing to his
co-trustees.
(2) A trustee shall cease to be a trustee immediately upon –
(a) The delivery of a notice of resignation under subsection (1);
(b) His removal from office by the Court;
(c) His removal from office by the protector of the trust;
(d) The coming into effect of or the exercise of a power under a provision
in the terms of the trust under which he is removed from, or
otherwise ceases to hold, his office.
(3) A person who ceases to be a trustee shall do everything necessary to
vest the trust property in the new or continuing trustees.
(4) When a trustee resigns or is removed –
(a) He shall, subject to paragraph (b), daily surrender all trust property
held by or vested in him or otherwise under his control;
(b) He may require that he be provided with reasonable security for
liabilities (existing, future, contingent or other) before surrendering
the trust property.
(5) A former trustee shall not be liable to any trustee or to any beneficiary
or other person interested under the trust for any act or omission in relation to the

Trusts Act 1994 1711

trust property or to his functions as a trustee, except for any liability –
(a) Arising from a breach of trust to which the trustee (or, in the case of
a corporate trustee, any of its officers or employees) was a party or
was privy;
(b) In respect of an action to recover from the trustee (or, in the case of
a corporate trustee, any of its officers or employees) trust property
or the proceeds thereof in his possession or under his control.

24 Nature of trustees’ and protectors’ interests

(1) Subject to subsection (2) –
(a) The interest of a trustee or protector in the trust property is limited
to that which is necessary for the proper performance of the trust;
and
(b) The trust property does not form part of the trustee’s or protector ’s
estate.
(2) Where a trustee or protector of a trust is also a beneficiary of it,
subsection (1) does not apply to his interest as a beneficiary.
(3) Where a trustee or protector becomes insolvent, or upon his property
becoming liable to distraint, seizure, sequestration or similar process of law, his
creditors shall have no recourse against the trust property except to the extent
that the trustee or protector himself has a claim against it or a beneficial interest in
it.

25 Corporate trustee may act by resolution

A corporate trustee may –
(a) Act in connection with a trust by a resolution of the corporate trustee
or of its Board of Directors or other governing body; or
(b) Appoint an officer or employee to act on its behalf in connection
with the trust.

26 Trustees of more than one trust

(1) A trustee is not, in the absence of fraud, affected by notice of any
instrument, matter, fact or thing in relation to a trust if he obtained notice of it by
reason of his acting or having acted as trustee of another trust.
(2) A trustee of a trust shall disclose to his co-trustees any interest which
he has as trustee of another trust if any transaction in relation to the first mentioned
trust is to be entered into with the trustees of the other trust.

27 Dealings by trustees with third parties

(1) Where, in a transaction or matter affecting a trust, a trustee informs a
third party that he is acting as trustee, a claim by the third party in respect of the
transaction or matter shall, subject to subsection (3), extend only to the trust
property.
(2) If the trustee fails to inform the third party that he is acting as trustee –
(a) He incurs personal liability to the third party in respect of the
transaction or matter; and
(b) He has a right of indemnity against the trust property in respect of
his personal liability, unless he acted in breach of trust.
(3) Nothing in this section shall prejudice any claim for breach of warranty
or authority.
1712

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

(4) A bona fide purchaser for value without notice of a breach of trust – (a) May deal with a trustee in relation to trust property as if the trustee
were the beneficial owner of it; and
(b) Is not affected by the trusts on which the property is held.
(5) A third party paying or advancing money to a trustee is not concerned
to see –
(a) That the money is needed in the proper exercise of the trust functions;
(b) That no more than is so needed is raised; or
(c) That the transaction or the application of the money is proper.
(6) In this section “third party” means a person other than a settlor, trustee,
protector or beneficiary of the trust.
PART 4
DUTIES AND POWERS OF TRUSTEES

28 General duties of trustees

(1) A trustee shall in the execution of his functions –
(a) Act with due diligence; and
(b) Observe utmost good faith; and
(c) Act to the best of his skills and abilities; and
(d) Exercise the standard or care of a reasonable and prudent man of
business.
(2) A trustee shall carry out and administer the trust under this Act and,
subject to it, in accordance with the terms of the trust.
(3) A trustee shall owe a fiduciary duty to the beneficiaries of the trust, the
members of a class for whose benefit the trust was established, or the purpose for
which the trust was established.
(4) Where a fiduciary duty is owed to a purpose for which a trust was
established, that duty may be enforced by the protector of the trust or (in the case
of a trust established for a charitable purpose) by the Minister.
(5) A trustee shall, subject to the terms of the trust and to the provisions of
this Act –
(a) Ensure that the trust property is held by or vested in him or is otherwise under his control; and
(b) Preserve and, so far as is reasonable, enhance the value of the trust
property.
(6) Except with the approval of the Court or in accordance with the terms
of the trust or the provisions of this Act, a trustee shall not –
(a) Derive, directly or indirectly, any profit from his trusteeship;
(b) Cause or permit any other person directly or indirectly to derive
any profit from his trusteeship; or
(c) On his own account enter into any transaction with his co-trustees
or relating to the trust property which may result in any such profit.
(7) The trustee of a trust shall keep accurate accounts and records of his
trusteeship.
(8) A trustee shall keep trust property separate from his own property and
separately identifiable from any other property of which he is a trustee.

Trusts Act 1994 1713

29 Duty to supply information and duty of confidentiality

(1) A trustee shall so far as reasonable and within a reasonable time of
receiving a request in writing to that effect, provide full and accurate information
as to the state and amount of the trust property and the conduct of the trust
administration to –
(a) The Court;
(b) The settlor or protector of the trust;
(c) In the case of a trust established for a charitable purpose, the
Minister;
(d) Subject to the terms of the trust, any beneficiary of the trust who is
of full age and capacity; and
(e) Subject to the terms of the trust, any charity for the benefit of which
the trust was established.
(2) Subject to this Act and to the terms of the trust, and except as is necessary
for the proper administration of the trust or by reason of any other Act, the trustee
of a trust shall keep confidential all information regarding the state and amount
of the trust property or the conduct of the trust administration.
(3) A trustee is not (subject to the terms of the trust and to any order of the
Court) obliged to disclose documents which reveal –
(a) His deliberations as to how he should exercise his functions as
trustee;
(b) The reasons for any decision made in the exercise of those functions;
(c) Any material upon which such a decision was or might have been
based.

30 Duty of trustees to act together

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust, all the trustees of a trust shall join in
the execution of the trust.
(2) Subject to subsections (3) and (4), no functions conferred on trustees
shall be exercised unless all the trustees agree on their exercise.
(3) Subject to the terms of the trust and to subsection (4), any functions
conferred on trustees of a charitable trust shall be exercised if more than one of
the trustees for the time being of the trust agree on their exercise.
(4) The terms of a trust may empower the trustees to act individually or
by a majority with respect to the exercise of some of all of the functions conferred
on the trustees or to delegate the exercise of these functions to one or more trustees.
(5) A trustee who dissents from a decision of the majority of trustees or of
a co-trustee or of the trustees to whom any functions have been delegated may
require his dissent to be recorded in writing.

31 Duty to act impartially

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust, where a trust is established for one or
more beneficiaries or purposes (whether concurrent or consecutive), a trustee (other
than a trustee who is also a beneficiary) shall act impartially as between these
beneficiaries and purposes.
(2) Subject to the terms of the trust and to the provisions of this Act, any
rule of law which requires a trustee to buy, hold or sell certain investments or to
apportion the capital or income of the trust fund between beneficiaries is hereby
abolished.
1714 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

32 General powers of trustees

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust and the provisions of the Act, a trustee
shall have in relation to the trust property all the powers of a beneficial owner.
(2) Subject to the terms of the trust and the provisions of this Act, a trustee
shall exercise his functions only in the interests of the beneficiaries or of the purpose
for which the trust is established and in accordance with the terms of the trust.
(3) Where the terms of a trust provide that the trustee may add or remove
beneficiaries or purposes for which the trust is established, then if such power is
exercised properly and on the basis of valid considerations the exercise of the
power shall not be regarded as a breach of the duty of the trustee under the trust.
(4) A trustee may sue and be sued as trustee.
(5) The terms of a trust may require a trustee to consult or obtain the consent
of another person before exercising any functions under this trust.
(6) Where he considers it necessary or desirable in the interests of the good
administration of the trust, a trustee may consult a lawyer, accountant, investment
advisor or other person in relation to the affairs of the trust.
(7) A person shall not, merely by virtue of giving or refusing his consent to
the exercise of any functions or being consulted in relation to the affairs of a trust,
be deemed to be a trustee or to owe a fiduciary duty to the beneficiaries of the
trust.

33 Powers of investment

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust and to the provisions of this Act, a
trustee may invest any money requiring investment in any investment or property
of whatsoever nature and wheresoever situated and whether producing income
or not and whether involving any liability or not and upon such security (if any)
as the trustee shall in his absolute discretion think fit as if the trustee were the
absolute owner of it.
(2) Where the terms of a trust or any other instrument provide that any
money requiring investing shall only be invested in “authorised trustee
investments” (or any similar expression) then the money shall be invested only in
such investments as are specified in Schedule 1.
(3) The terms of a trust may provide that Schedule 1 shall apply to the
trust with such modifications as are specified by the terms of the trust.
(4) Cabinet may, on the advice of the Minister, by Order published in the

Gazette amend the list of authorised trustee investments in paragraph 1 of Schedule

1.
(5) A trustee shall not be liable for breach of trust by reason only of continuing to hold an investment which has ceased to be an investment authorised by the terms of the trust or by the general law.
(6) Subject to the terms of the trust, in selecting investments a trustee or
(as the case may be) any investment advisor or other person to whom the trustee
has delegated the management of the trust property shall have regard –
(a) To the need of diversification of investments in the trust, in so far
as is appropriate to the circumstances of the trust; and
(b) To the suitability to the trust of the investments proposed.
(7) Subject to the terms of the trust, before investing money in any
investment a trustee shall consider whether he should obtain appropriate advice
as to whether the investment is suitable and satisfactory and (if he considers that
the obtaining of such advice is necessary) shall obtain and consider such advice
accordingly.

Trusts Act 1994 1715

(8) Subject to the terms of the trust, a trustee shall determine whether and at what intervals he should obtain appropriate advice as to whether the existing investments of the trust are suitable and satisfactory and (if he considers that the obtaining of such advice is necessary) shall obtain ad consider such advice accordingly.
(9) For the purposes of subsections (7) and (8), advice is appropriate if it is
the advice of a person who is reasonably believed by the trustee to be qualified to
give such advice; and such advice may be given by a person notwithstanding that
he gives it in the course of his employment (including employment with a trustee
of the trust).

34 Implied powers of trustee

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust, the powers contained in Schedule 2
shall apply to all trusts to which this section applies.
(2) The terms of a trust may provide that some or all of the powers
contained in Schedule 2 shall apply to that trust and with or without modification.

35 Delegation by trustees

(1) A trustee may not delegate the exercise of his functions unless permitted
to do so by this Act or by the terms of the trust.
(2) Except where the terms of the trust provide to the contrary, a trustee
may –
(a) Delegate the management of trust property to and appoint investment managers whom the trustee reasonably considers to be qualified to manage the investment of the trust property;
(b) Appoint and employ any lawyer, accountant or other person to act in relation to any of the affairs of the trust or to hold any of the trust property; and
(c) Authorise any such manager or person to retain or receive
commission or other payment usually payable for services of the
description rendered.
(3) A trustee shall not be liable for any loss arising to the trust from a
delegation or appointment under subsection (2) or from the default of any such delegate or appointee provided that the trustee exercised the standard of care of a reasonable and prudent man of business in –
(a) The selection of the delegate or appointee; and
(b) The supervision of the activities of the delegate or appointee.

36 Reimbursements of expenses

A trustee shall be entitled to be reimbursed out of the trust property all
expenses properly incurred by him in connection with the trust.

37 Payment of trustees

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust, an individual trustee engaged in any
profession or business shall be entitled to charge and be paid all usual professional
or other charges for business transacted, time spent and acts done by him or any
partner or employee of his or of his firm in connection with the trust including
acts which a trustee not being engaged in any profession or business could have
done personally.
(2) Subject to the terms of the trust, a corporate trustee shall be entitled to
such remuneration as may from time to time be agreed in writing between such
corporation and the settlor or protector of (in the absence of such agreement) in
accordance with its standard terms and conditions as to the administration of
trusts current from time to time.
1716 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(3) Where the terms of the trust provide that a trustee shall not receive any payment for acting as such, payment may nevertheless be authorised –
(a) By the Court; or
(b) By some or all of the beneficiaries of the trust:
Provided that a beneficiary may not authorise such payment if the beneficiary –
(i) is a minor or a person under legal disability;
(ii) does not have full knowledge of all material facts; or
(iii) is improperly induced by the trustee to authorise such payment.
(4) Where only some of the beneficiaries authorise payment to a trustee
under subsection (3), the payment shall be made out of the share of the trust
property which in the opinion of the trustee is referable to the interests of those
beneficiaries who so authorise payment.

38 Power to appropriate

Subject to the terms of the trust, a trustee may, without the consent of any
beneficiary, appropriate trust property in or towards satisfaction of the interest of
a beneficiary in such manner and in accordance with such valuation as he considers
appropriate.

39 Power and duty of maintenance

Subject to the terms of the trust and to any prior interest or charge affecting
the trust property, where any property is held by a trustee in trust for any
beneficiary for any interest whatsoever –
(a) While the beneficiary is a minor, the trustee –
(i) may pay to the parent or guardian of the beneficiary or
otherwise apply the whole or part of the income attributable
to that interest for or towards the maintenance, education or
benefit of the beneficiary; and
(ii) shall accumulate the residue of that income as an accretion to
the trust property and as one fund with the trust property for
all purposes:
Provided that the trustee may while the beneficiary is a minor apply those
accumulations as if they were income of the then current year; and
(b) If the beneficiary is no longer a minor and his interest has not yet
vested in possession, the trustee shall thenceforth pay the income
attributable to the interest to the beneficiary until his interest vests
in possession or terminates.

40 Power of advancement

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust, a trustee may in his discretion pay or
apply trust property for the advancement or benefit of any beneficiary whose
interest in the trust has not yet vested in possession.
(2) (a) Any trust property so paid or applied shall be brought into account
in determining the share of the beneficiary in the trust property.
(b) No such payment or application shall be made which prejudices
any person entitled to any prior interest unless such person is of
full age and consents to the payment or application or (if such person
is not of full age) the Court consents.
(c) The part of the trust property so paid or advanced shall not exceed
the presumptive share of the beneficiary in the trust property.

Trusts Act 1994 1717

41 Accumulation and maintenance settlements

Where property is directed to be held on accumulation and maintenance
trusts for the benefit of a beneficiary or a class of beneficiaries, the provisions of
sections 40 and 41 (unless the terms of the trust otherwise provide) apply to the
interest of such beneficiary or beneficiaries.

42 Receipts of parents or guardians

The receipt of a parent or guardian of a beneficiary who is a minor or is
under legal disability shall be a sufficient discharge to the trustee for a payment
made to or for the benefit of the beneficiary.

43 Power of appointment

The terms of a trust may confer on the trustee or any other person power to
appoint all or any part of the trust property or any interest in the trust property to,
or to trustees for the benefit of, any person or valid charitable or non-charitable
purpose (whether or not such person was a beneficiary of the trust or such purpose
was an object of the trust prior to such appointment).

44 Power of revocation or variation

(1) A trust and any exercise of a power or discretion under a trust may be
expressed to be capable of revocation (in whole or in part) or of variation.
(2) No such revocation or variation shall prejudice anything lawfully done
by a trustee in relation to the trust before he receives notice of the revocation or
variation.
(3) Subject to the terms of the trust, if a trust is revoked in whole or in part,
the trustee shall hold the trust property, or the part of the trust property which is
the subject of the revocation, in trust for the settlor absolutely or, if he is dead, as
if it had formed part of his estate at death.
(4) In so far as the terms of a trust make no provision for revocation of the
trust, then the trust shall be irrevocable.
PART 5
TERMINATION OR FAILURE OF TRUSTS

45 Failure or lapse of interest

(1) Subject to the terms of the trust and to any order of the Court, where –
(a) An interest lapses;
(b) A trust terminates; or
(c) There is no beneficiary and no person (whether or not then living)
who can become a beneficiary in accordance with the terms of the
trust;
the interest or property concerned shall be held by the trustee in trust for the
settlor absolutely, if he is dead, as if it had formed part of his estate at death.
(2) Subsection (1) shall not apply to a trust established for a charitable
purpose to which section 46 applies.

46 Application of property held on charitable trusts

(1) Where trust property is held for a charitable purpose and –
(a) The purpose has been, as far as may be, fulfilled;
(b) The purpose cannot be carried out at all, or not under directions
given and to the spirit of the gift;
(c) The purpose provides a use for part only of the property;
1718 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(d) The property, and other property applicable for a similar purpose, can be more effectively used in conjunction, and to that end can more suitably be applied to a common purpose;
(e) The purpose was laid down by reference to an area which was then, but has since ceased to be a unit for some other purpose, or by reference to a class of persons or to an area which has for any reason since ceased to be suitable or to be practicable in administering the gift;
(f) The purpose has been adequately provided for by other means;
(g) The purpose has ceased to be charitable (by being useless or harmful
to the community or otherwise); or
(h) The purpose has ceased in any other way to provide a suitable and
effective method of using the property;
the property, or the remainder of the property, as the case may be, shall be held for
such other charitable purpose as the Court, on the application of the Minister or
the trustee, may declare to be consistent with the original intention of the settlor.
(2) Where trust property is held for a charitable purpose, the Court, on the
application of the Minister or the trustee, may approve any arrangement which
varies or revokes the purposes or terms of the trust or enlarges or modifies the
powers of management or administration of the trustee, if it is satisfied that the
arrangement –
(a) Is no suitable or expedient; and
(b) Is consistent with the original intention of the settlor.
(3) The Court shall not make a declaration under subsection (1) or approve
an arrangement under subsection (2) unless satisfied that any person with a
material interest in the trust has had an opportunity of being heard.

47 Termination of trusts

(1) On the termination of a trust, the trust property shall, subject to
subsection (2), be distributed by the trustee within a reasonable time in accordance
with the terms of the trust to the persons entitled.
(2) The trustee may retain sufficient assets to make reasonable provision
for liabilities (existing, future, contingent or other).

48 Termination by beneficiaries

(1) Without prejudice to any power of the Court and notwithstanding
the terms of the trust, where all the beneficiaries are in existence and have been
ascertained, and none is a person under legal disability or a minor, and all
beneficiaries are in agreement so to do, they may require the trustee to terminate
the trust and distribute the trust property as the beneficiaries direct.
(2) A beneficiary of an interest under a protective or spendthrift trust may
not enter into such an agreement as is referred to in subsection (1).

49 Variation of trusts

PART 6
VARIATION OF TRUSTS
(1) The Court may, on the application of any beneficiary, the trustee, the settlor or his personal representatives, or the protector of a trust, approve on behalf of –
(a) A minor or a person under legal disability having, directly or
indirectly, an interest, vested or contingent, under the trust;
(b) Any person unborn;

Trusts Act 1994 1719

(c) Any person who is presently unascertained but who may become entitled, directly or indirectly, to an interest under the trust, as being (at a future date or on the happening of a future event) a person of any specified description or a member of any specified class; or
(d) Any person, in respect of an interest that may accrue to him by virtue of the exercise of a discretionary power on the failure or determination of an interest under a protective or spendthrift trust –
any arrangement which varies or revokes the terms of the trust or enlarges or modified the powers of management or administration of the trustee, whether or not there is another person with a beneficial interest who is capable of assenting to the arrangement:
(2) The Court shall not approve an arrangement on behalf of a person
mentioned in subsection (1) (a), (b) or (c) unless the arrangement appears to be for
his benefit.

50 Approval of particular transaction

Where, in the management or administration of a trust, a transaction is, in
the opinion of the Court, expedient, but cannot be effected because the necessary
power has not been conferred on the trustee by the terms of the trust or by law,
the Court, on the application of the trustee –
(a) May confer upon the trustee, generally or in any particular
circumstances, the necessary power, on such terms and subject to
such conditions as the Court thinks fit; and
(b) May direct the manner in which, and the property from which, any
monies authorised to be expended, and the costs of any transaction,
are to be paid or borne.
PART 7
BREACH OF TRUST

51 Liability for breach of trust

(1) Subject to this Act and to the terms of the trust, a trustee who commits
or concurs in a breach of trust is liable for –
(a) Any loss or depreciation in value of the trust property resulting
from the breach; and
(b) Any profit which would have accrued to the trust had there been
no breach.
(2) A trustee may not set-off a profit accruing from one breach of trust
against a loss or depreciation in value resulting from another.
(3) A trustee is not liable for a breach of trust committed by another person
prior to his appointment or for a breach of trust committed by a co-trustee unless –
(a) He becomes or ought to have become aware of the breach; and
(b) He actively conceals the breach, or fails within a reasonable time to
take proper steps to protect or restore the trust property or to prevent
the breach.
(4) Where trustees are liable for a breach of trust, they are liable jointly and
severally.
(5) A trustee who becomes aware of a breach of trust shall take all
reasonable steps to have the breach remedied.
(6) Nothing in terms of a trust shall relieve a trustee of liability for a breach
of trust arising from his own fraud or wilful misconduct.
1720 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

52 Constructive trusts

(1) A person who derives a profit from a breach of trust, or who obtains
property in breach of trust, shall be deemed to be a trustee of the property, unless
he derives or obtains it in good faith and without actual constructive or implied
notice of the breach of trust.
(2) A person who becomes a trustee by virtue of subsection (1) shall deliver
up the profit or property to the person properly entitled to it.
(3) This section does not exclude any other circumstances in which a
constructive trust may arise.

53 Tracing trust property

Without prejudice to the personal liability of a trustee, trust property which
has been charged or dealt with in breach of trust, or any property into which it has
been converted, may be followed and recovered unless –
(a) It is no longer identifiable; or
(b) It is in the hands of a bona fide purchaser for value without actual,
constructive or implied notice of the breach of trust.

54 Beneficiary may relieve or indemnify a trustee

(1) A beneficiary may relieve a trustee of liability to him for a breach of
trust or indemnify a trustee against liability for a breach of trust.
(2) Subsection (1) does not apply if the beneficiary –
(a) Is a minor or a person under legal disability;
(b) Does not have full knowledge of all material facts; or
(c) Is improperly induced by the trustee to act under subsection (1).

55 Power to relieve trustees from personal liability

The Court may relieve a trustee wholly or partly of liability for a breach of
trust where it appears to the Court that the trustee has acted honestly and
reasonably and ought fairly to be excused for the breach of trust or for omitting to
obtain the directions of the Court in the matter in which the breach arose.

56 Power to make beneficiaries indemnify

Where a trustee commits a breach of trust at the instigation, at the request
or with the concurrence of a beneficiary, the Court (whether or not the beneficiary
is a minor or a person under legal disability) may impound all or part of his interest
by way of indemnity to the trustee or any person claiming through him.

57 Limitation and prescription

(1) No period of limitation or prescription applies to an action brought
against a trustee –
(a) In respect of any fraud to which the trustee was a party or was
privy; or
(b) To recover from the trustee trust property or the proceeds of it –
(i) held by or vested in him or otherwise in his possession or under
his control; or
(ii) previously received by him or converted to his use.
(2) Subject to subsection (1), the period within which an action founded
on breach of trust may be brought against a trustee is –
(a) Three years from delivery of the final accounts of the trust to the
beneficiaries; or
(b) Three years from the date on which the plaintiff first has knowledge
of the breach of trust, whichever period first begins to run.

Trusts Act 1994 1721

(3) Where the plaintiff if a minor or a person under legal disability, the period referred to in subsection (2) does not begin to run until his minority or disability, as the case may be, ceases.
PART 8
POWERS OF THE COURT

58 Jurisdiction of the Court

The Court has jurisdiction in respect of any matters concerning a trust
where –
(a) The proper law of the trust is the law of Niue; (b) A trustee of the trust is resident in Niue;
(c) Any property of the trust is situated in Niue;
(d) Any part of the administration of the trust is carried on in Niue.

59 General powers of the Court

(1) On the application of a trustee, a beneficiary, a settlor or his personal
representatives, a protector (in the case of a trust established for a charitable
purpose) the Minister or, with the leave of the Court, any other person the Court
may –
(a) Make an order in respect of –
(i) the execution, administration or enforcement of a trust;
(ii) a trustee, including an order as to the exercise by a trustee of
his functions, the removal of a trustee, the appointment,
remuneration or conduct of a trustee, the keeping and
submission of accounts, and the making of payments whether
into Court or otherwise;
(iii) a protector, including an order appointing a protector;
(iv) a beneficiary, or any person connected with a trust;
(v) any trust property, including an order as to the vesting,
preservation, application, surrender or recovery of it;
(b) Make a declaration as to the validity or enforceability of a trust;
(c) Direct the trustee to distribute, or not to distribute the trust property;
(d) Make such order in respect of the termination of the trust and the
distribution of the property as it thinks fit;
(e) Rescind or vary an order or declaration under this Act, or make a
new or further order or declaration.
(2) Where the Court appoints or removes a trustee under this section –
(a) It may impose such requirements and conditions as it thinks fit,
including provisions as to remuneration and requirements or
conditions as to the vesting of trust property;
(b) Subject to the Court’s order, a trustee appointed by the Court has
the same functions, and may act in all respects, as if he had been
originally appointed a trustee.
(3) If a person does not comply with an order of the Court under this Act
requiring him to do any thing, the Court may, on such terms and conditions as it
thinks fit, order that the thing be done by another person, nominated for the
purpose by the Court, at the expense of the person in default (or otherwise, as the
Court directs) and a thing so done has effect in all respects as if done by the person
in default.
1722 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

60 Applications for directions

A trustee may apply to the Court for directions as to how he should or
might act in any of the affairs of the trust, and the Court may make such order as
it thinks fit.

61 Payment of costs

The Court may order the costs and expenses of and incidental to an
application of the Court under this Act to be paid from the trust property or in
such manner and by such persons as it thinks fit.

62 Variant types of trust

PART 9
VARIANT TYPES OF TRUST
(1) A settlor may create a trust (in whatever form and whatever name it is known) of a type recognised by the law or rules of his religion or nationality or which is customarily used by his community, provided that –
(a) There is a recital to that effect in the instrument creating the trust;
and
(b) The trust is of a type approved by the Minister by Order published
in the Gazette.
(2) The instrument creating a trust may be written in a language other
than English, provided that a version in the English language certified by the
original trustee to be a true translation is appended to the instrument.

63 Provisions of variant types of trust

A trust of a type approved under section 62 (1) may provide that the trustee
shall hold the trust property –
(a) For a period not exceeding 120 years, to pay or apply the income
and capital of it for the maintenance, education, advance or benefit
of the family of the settlor, and/or for the purpose of performing
acts or services in honour of the settlor or the ancestors of the settlor;
and
(b) Thereafter for the advancement of the settlor ’s religion, or for such
other charitable purpose as the settlor may specify or, if the settlor
has not specified a charitable purpose, for such charitable purpose
as the trustee shall determine.
PART 10
REGISTRATION OF TRUSTS AND EXEMPT TRUSTS

64 Facility to register trusts

(1) The Registrar of the Court shall maintain a register of trusts.
(2) The settlor or a trustee of a trust may apply to the Registrar to enter the
trust on the Register.
(3) An application for entry on the Register shall be accompanied by –
(a) A certified copy of the instrument creating the trust (if any); and
(b) A fee of $300.
(4) The Registrar shall, on receipt of an application for registration, a
certified copy of the instrument creating the trust (if any) and the required fee –
(a) Enter on the Register the name of the trust (if any), the name of the
settlor and the name of the beneficiary or the purpose for which
the trust is established; and
(b) Issue to the trustee a certificate of registration.

Trusts Act 1994 1723

(5) Where the terms of a trust which has been registered are varied, the trustee shall send to the Registrar a notification of such variation together with a fee of $150 and the Registrar shall amend the entry on the Register accordingly and issue an amended certificate of registration.
(6) Where a trust which has been registered terminates, the trustee shall notify the Registrar and return the certificate of registration and the Registrar shall then cancel the entry on the Register and the certificate of registration.
(7) The Register shall not be open for inspection except that the trustee of a trust may in writing authorise a person to inspect the entry of that trust on the Register.
(8) Notwithstanding subsection (7) and section 29, the Register shall be open to inspection by any foreign government or any court and tribunal of any other country including Niue but only if and to the extent that the Court so directs having been satisfied that the information is required and will be used solely for the purposes of an investigation or prosecution of any person in relation to the sale, or the laundering of the proceeds of sale, of any prohibited narcotic substances of the laundering of the proceeds gained from any other serious criminal activity whether that sale or laundering or other serious criminal activity occurred in Niue or elsewhere.
(9) The Minister may increase the fees payable under this section by Order in Cabinet.
(10) Nothing in subsection (7) shall prevent the Court from requiring any person to produce claimants or to give evidence in any proceedings of any facts relevant in such proceedings.

65

if –

Exemption from taxes and duties

(1) For the purposes of this Act a trust shall be an exempt trust in any year
(a) The settlor is not resident in Niue during that year;
(b) None of the beneficiaries are resident in Niue during that year; and
(c) The trust property does not include any land situated in Niue.
(2) In any year when a trust is an exempt trust, then, notwithstanding any
provision to the contrary in any enactment –
(a) The income of the trust for that year shall be exempt from all
provisions of the Income Tax Act 1961;
(b) No estate, inheritance, succession or gift tax or duty shall be payable
with respect to the trust property by reason of any death occurring
during that year; and
(c) All instruments executed in that year and relating to the trust
property or to transactions carried out by the trustee on behalf of
the trust shall be exempt from stamp duty.
(3) In this section “resident” means resident for the purposes of the Income
Tax Act 1961.
–––––––––––––––––––
1724 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Authorised Trustee Investments

(a) Securities issued by, or the payment of interest on which is guaranteed

by, the Government of Niue or by any other sovereign state;

(b) Securities issued by, or the payment of interests on which is guaranteed

by, any of the African Development Bank, the Asian Development Bank,

the Caribbean Development Bank, the European Economic Community,

the European Investment Bank, the International Finance Corporation,

the International Monetary Fund, or the International Bank for

Reconstruction and Development;

(c) Any trustee investments authorised by the Trustee Act 1956, the

Commonwealth of Australia or any State or Territory of it, or the United

Kingdom;

(d) Securities issued by or deposits with any Bank registered with the relevant

authorities in any of the jurisdictions in subparagraph (c) or in the United

States of American, the Cook Islands, or Niue;

(e) Freehold property situated in any of the jurisdictions in subparagraph (c)

or leasehold property situated in Niue of which the unexpired term of

the end of the investment is not less than 40 years.

–––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 2

Implied Powers of Trustees

Trust for Sale and Investment

1 (1) The trustee shall hold real or immovable property included in the trust

property on trust for sale with power to postpone the sale of the whole or any part of it

for such period as he thinks fit and shall hold all other investments included in the trust

property on trust either (at his discretion) to retain them for such period as he thinks fit or

to sell or otherwise dispose of the whole or any part of them.

(2) The trustee shall hold all money received or held by him as capital money

(including the net proceeds of such sale) on trust to invest it in any manner authorised by

the terms of the trust as he thinks fit.

(3) The trustee may change investments included in the trust property into others

authorised by the terms of the trust.

Powers respecting trustee investments

2 (1) Where in the event that any land, building or chattel were producing income,

the whole of suchincome would or might be payable to any person under the terms of the

trust, the trustee may permit such person together with the members of his household to

reside in and occupy such land or buildings or to enjoy the use or benefit of such chattels

either gratuitously or on such terms as the trustee shall think fit.

(2) The trustee shall have power to purchase any land, building or chattel or any

interest in it in any jurisdiction, provided that the power to purchase land in Niue shall

be limited to the purchase of a leasehold interest only, for the use or occupation of any

one or more persons (such use or occupation to be only under subparagraph (1) or partly

for such use and partly as an investment.

(3) The trustee shall have power to employ any capital of the trust property or to

take such other steps as may be requisite to insure, protect, maintain or preserve or to

improve the value of or to guard against any loss of value of the trust property or the

income thereof.

Trusts Act 1994 1725

Corporations

3 (1) The trustee may promote or incorporate any corporation to carry on any trade

or hold any investments.

(2) Where all or any part of the capital of a corporation is included in the trust

property the assets of such corporation shall not be impressed with any of the trusts but

the trustee may nevertheless cause or procure such corporation to do any act or thing as

regards the assets of the corporation as he is empowered to do as regards the trust property.

Appropriation

4 The trustee shall have power to appropriate any investments or property forming

part of the trust property in its actual state of investment in or towards the satisfaction of

the beneficial interest of any person interested in the trust property upon making such

valuation if any as the trustee may think fit and without the necessity of obtaining the

consent of any person.

Holding and Custody of Investments

5 Investments included in the trust property may be held by or in the name of or

under the control of any person (whether or not a trustee) as nominee or bailee for the

trustee and in that case the trustee shall not be responsible for any default of such nominee

or bailee of good standing appointed in good faith.

Land

6 Subject to the Land Act 1969, the Niue Amendment Act 1968 and any relevant

principles of land law applicable to Niue, where the trust property includes any land (in

this paragraph called “the Land” –

(a) The trustee may lease, mortgage, charge, grant any licence over (whether

exclusive or not) and otherwise dispose of the Land or any interest in it

provided that there shall be no power to sell, mortgage or exchange land

in Niue;

(b) The trustee may spend capital money on erecting buildings on the Land

or on demolishing and rebuilding or on altering or improving buildings

on it or otherwise on improving the Land as he thinks fit (and any

certificate of any architect or surveyor employed by the trustee or of any

trustee who is qualified as an architect or surveyor that the work specified

in such certificate consists only of alteration or improvement shall be

conclusive as between the trustee and all persons interested under the

trust that any capital money spent on such work was properly spent by

the trustee in exercise of the powers conferred by this subparagraph);

(c) The trustee may observe and perform all obligations imposed on or

incurred by him as owner or lessor or lessee of the Land and shall be

entitled to be indemnified out of every part of the trust property against

all personal liability imposed on him by or by any breach of any one or

more of such obligations and in this subparagraph “obligations” includes

every obligation whether imposed by contract or by general law or

otherwise;

(d) The trustee may employ any of the capital of the trust property in

repairing, developing, enlarging, equipping, furnishing, insuring and

maintaining the Land and buildings and fixtures on it.

7 Where the trust property includes any chattel the trustee may employ any of the

capital of the trust property in repairing or insuring such chattel and may store, lend or

hire on such terms as he thinks fit.

1726 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

Borrowing

8 (1) The trustee may borrow on such terms as he thinks fit and for such purpose

may mortgage or charge all or any of the assets included in the trust property.

(2) The trustee shall hold any borrowed money as capital of the trust property

and as one fund with other money and investments included in the trust property or as a

separate fund as he shall think fit and shall invest, advance, distribute, pay or otherwise

deal with such money in accordance with the trusts and powers relating to the capital of

the trust property.

(3) The trustee may repay borrowed money and pay interest out of the capital of

the trust property.

Insurance

9 The trustee may effect and maintain out of the capital of the trust property any

policy of insurance or assurance upon the life of any person or under which the death of

any person is one of the events under which money becomes payable.

Loans to Beneficiaries

10 Where in the event that any money forming part only of the trust property were

producing income the whole of such income would or might be payable to any person

under the terms of the trust the trustee may lend such money to that person either free of

interest or upon such terms relating to interest and to repayment and either with or without

security as the trustee thinks fit.

Release of Powers

11 The trustee may in his absolute discretion at any time and by instrument in writing

release or restrict the future exercise of any powers conferred on him by the terms of the

trust or by the general law either wholly or to the extent specified in any such instrument.

Trustees Appointed as Directors

12 Any trustee who shall be or become a director or the holder of any other office or

employment in any company any of whose shares shall form part of the trust property

shall be entitled to retain for his own use and benefit any reasonable fees or remuneration

received by him in connection with such office or employment notwithstanding that his

appointment to or retention of such office or employment may be directly or indirectly

due to the exercise or non-exercise of any votes in respect of any of the shares forming

part of the trust property.

Associated Parties

13 If the trustee places or causes to be placed any banking, broking or other business

with an associated or other person so that (but for this paragraph) he would be liable to

account in any manner to the trust property he shall ensure that such business is done on

such terms as that person would make with an unassociated customer or client and if he

does so he shall not be required to account for any receipt from or profit of such person

from such business.

Sundry Powers

14 (1) The powers of the trustee shall extend to any and every act or omission of the

trustee which is necessary or desirable for the due execution of the trust and the protection

and realisation and the due administration of the investments in the trust property and

the cost of and incidental to every act of the trustee shall be met out of income or capital

of the trust property or partly out of each (as the trustee thinks fit).

(2) In addition to all the powers vested in the trustee by the terms of the trust or

the general law the trustee shall have and may exercise the following powers

(a) To compromise and settle for such consideration and upon such terms

and conditions as the trustee may consider advisable all matters arising

in relation to the trust;

Trusts Act 1994 1727

(b) To pay out of the income or capital of the trust property all the costs of and incidental to the preparation and execution of the trust instrument;

(c) To receive any property from any person as an addition to the trust property either by gift inter vivos or by will or under the provisions of any other trust or otherwise.

Revocable Appointments

15 Any revocable appointment, decision or resolution of the trustee may be treated

by him for any purpose as irrevocable unless and until it is revoked.

1728 Niue W:ws 2006 Vol3

1729

UNITED NATIONS ACT 1946

1946/7 (NZ) – 16 September 1946

1

Short title

3 Liability for breach of regulations

2

Power to make regulations to enable effect

4-5 [Spent]

to be given to article 41

To confer on the Governor-General in Council power to make regulations to enable New Zealand to fulfil the obligations undertaken by it under article

41 of the Charter of the United Nations

WHEREAS New Zealand is a member of the United Nations and as such is bound by the Charter of the United Nations signed at San Francisco on 26 June, 1945: And whereas article 41 of the Charter is in the following terms:

Article 41

The Security Council may decide what measures not involving the use of
armed force are to be employed to give effect to its decisions, and it may call upon
the members of the United Nations to apply such measures. These may include
complete or partial interruption of economic relations and of rail, seal, air, postal,
telegraphic, radio and other means of communication, and the severance of
diplomatic relations:
AND WHEREAS it is desirable that provision should be made to enable
New Zealand to fulfil its obligations under the said article:

1 Short title

This is the United Nations Act 1946.

2 Power to make regulations to enable effect to be given to article 41

(1) If, under article 41 of the Charter of the United Nations the Security
Council of the United Nations calls upon the Government of New Zealand to
apply any measures to give effect to any decision of that Council, the Cabinet of
Niue may make all regulations as appear to it to be necessary or expedient for
enabling those measures to be effectively applied.
(2) No regulation made under this Act shall be deemed to be invalid
because it deals with any matter already provided for by any Act, or because of
any repugnancy to any Act.
1730 Niue Laws 2005 Vol 1

3 Liability for breach of regulations

Every person who commits, or attempts to commit, or does any act with
intent to commit, or counsels, procures, aids, abets, or incites any other person to
commit, or conspires with any other person (whether in Niue or elsewhere) to
commit any offence against any regulations made under this Act shall be liable on
summary conviction, in the case of an individual, to imprisonment for a term not
exceeding 12 months or to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units or, in the case of a
company or other corporation, to a fine not exceeding 20 penalty units.

4-5 [Spent]

1731

VILLAGE COUNCILS ACT 1967

1967/41 – 1 May1967

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

1

Short title

2

Interpretation

PART 2

ADMINISTRATION

3

Administration of Act

4

Advisers

5

Powers of inspection

6

Appeals

7

Annual reports

PART 3

ESTABLISHMENT OF COUNCILS

8

Establishment and constitution of Village

Councils

9

Councils to be bodies corporate

10

Power to vary the constitution of councils

PART 4

ENROLMENT, ELECTIONS

11

Qualifications of electors

12

Electoral rolls

13

General provisions

14

Qualifications for membership

15

Elections

16

Tenure of office

17

Vacation of office

18

Removal from office

19

Casual vacancies

PART 5

MEETINGS

20

Chairmen, Deputy Chairmen

21

Standing Orders

22

Meetings of councils

23

Meetings of councils

24

Quorum and voting at meetings

25

Minutes

26

Councillors not to vote on certain matters

PART 6

POWERS, DUTIES, OF COUNCILS

27

General functions of Councils

28

Agency functions for Government

1732 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

58

Application of fines

60

Public purposes

61

Regulations

PART 11

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

SCHEDULE

58

Judicial notice

To provide for the establishment of village councils

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Village Councils Act 1967.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“adviser”, in relation to a Council, means an adviser appointed under
section 4 for that Council;
“auditor”, in relation to a Council, means the Council auditor appointed
under section 48 for that Council;
“Community Development Officer” means the Community Development
Officer appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission and holding
that office in the Niue Public Service;
“constituent notice”, in relation to a Council means the notice or notices
published under Part 3;
“Council” means a Village Council established by or under this Act;
“Council area”, in relation to a Council, means the area in and for which
the Council is established;
“Council Clerk” in relation to a Council, means the Council Clerk appointed
for that Council;
“Council Officer”, in relation to a Council, means any official, other than
the Council Clerk, employed by the Council;
“election” means an election of a Councillor or Councillors;
“financial year” means the period of 12 months commencing on 1 April in
a year and ending 31 March next following;
“Liquidator”, in relation to a Council, means the Liquidator of the Council
appointed under section 52;
“Manager”, in relation to a Council, means the Manager appointed for the
Council under section 50;
“Secretary” means Secretary to the Government.

3 Administration of Act

PART 2
ADMINISTRATION
(1) The Community Development Officer shall be charged with the administration of this Act.
(2) The Community Development Officer may, by writing under his hand, delegate to any other officer of the public service all or any of his powers or functions under this Act (except this power of delegation).
(3) The Community Development Officer or any officer to whom any power or functions have been delegated under subsection (2) shall not be eligible to hold any other office under this Act in relation to a Council.

Village Councils Act 1967

1733

4 Advisers

(1) The Community Development Officer, with the concurrence of Cabinet
may by notice published in the Gazette appoint an officer of the public service to
set as adviser to a Council and define the particular duties and responsibilities of
each adviser.
(2) An adviser shall advise and assist the Council in accordance with the
duties and responsibilities prescribed by the Community Development Officer.
(3) An adviser is entitled to attend meetings of the Council and to take
part in debate, but is not entitled to vote and shall not be counted towards a
quorum.

5 Powers of inspection

The Community Development Officer, or any officer authorised by him
may at any time –
(a) Inspect the books, accounts or records kept or held by the Council;
and
(b) Enter on and inspect any land, building, premises, or machinery or
thing owned or controlled by the Council or in which the Council
has an interest.

6 Appeals

(1) A person (including a Council) aggrieved by a decision of the secretary
under section 18 may appeal to a Judge of the Court, whose decision shall be
final.
(2) A person (including a Council) aggrieved by a decision of the Community Development Officer under this Act (other than under section 18) may appeal to Cabinet whose decision shall be final.

7 Annual reports

(1) The Community Development Officer shall present to Cabinet on or
before 30 April in every year, for presentation to the Assembly, a report reviewing
the operation of this Act and of the Village Council system, and drawing attention
to any measures which are, in his opinion, desirable for achieving the purposes of
this Act and for improving the operation of that system.
(2) Each Council shall, on or before 10 April in every year, present to the
Community Development Officer, for presentation to Cabinet, a report reviewing
the operations of the Council during the 12 months ending on 31 March then last
past.
PART 3
ESTABLISHMENT OF COUNCILS

8 Establishment and Constitution of Village Councils

Cabinet may –
(a) By notice published in the Gazette, establish a Council in and for
the village described in the notice, and
(b) Either in the notice establishing a Council or by a subsequent notice,
make provisions for the manner in which the Council is to be
constituted, for the boundaries of the Council area and for the
manner of election to the Council.
1734 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

9 Councils to be bodies corporate

A Council is a body corporate by the name under which it is established
with perpetual succession and a common seal, and, subject to this Act, has power
to acquire, hold, dispose of, mortgage or pledge property, to enter into contracts,
to borrow money, to invest funds, to institute and defend actions, suits and other
legal proceedings, and to do all other things necessary for the purposes of its
functions and duties.

10 Power to vary the constitution of Councils

After consultation with the Council concerned, Cabinet may, by notice
published in the Gazette
(a) Vary the boundaries of a Council area in accordance with any change
made in the boundaries of a constituency under the Niue Assembly
Act 1966;
(b) Change the name of a Council; or
(c) Vary the constitution of a Council.
PART 4
ENROLMENT, ELECTIONS

11 Qualifications of electors

The qualifications and disqualifications of electors under this Act shall be
as provided under section 12 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966.

12 Electoral rolls

(1) The electoral rolls to be used for elections to Village Councils under
this Act shall be the same rolls as those required by section 13 of the Niue Assembly
Act 1966.
(2) The provisions as to the compulsory registration of electors under
section 14 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966 shall apply in like manner to the elections
for members of Village Councils under this Act.

13 General provisions

All other provisions as to electors and electoral rolls shall be as provided in
Part 3 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966.

14 Qualifications for membership

(1) Subject to subsection (2), a person who is entitled to be enrolled under
section 11 and is enrolled as an elector for his constituency, is qualified to nominate
a candidate for the Council in that constituency and to be a Councillor.
(2) A person is not qualified to nominate a candidate for a Council or to be
a Councillor if –
(a) He is an officer or employee of a Council;
(b) He is an undischarged bankrupt.

15 Elections

(1) All Village Councillors shall be elected by secret ballot, except as is
provided in section 19.
(2) Elections for individual Councils shall be held on such dates as are
specified by Cabinet by notice in the Gazette.
(3) Subject to this Act, the method of and the procedure to be followed at
an election shall be to all intents and purposes the same as is prescribed in the
Niue Assembly Act 1966 and in the conduct and supervision of any election under

Village Councils Act 1967

1735
this section the Chief Electoral Officer shall have due regard to the relevant provisions of that Act.
(4) In this section, the “Chief Electoral Officer” means the Chief Electoral
Officer appointed under section 3 of the Niue Assembly Act 1966.

16 Tenure of office

Subject to this Act and to anything to the contrary in the constituent notice,
the tenure of office of Councillors shall be 3 calendar years from and including the
day on which the first election is completed and, thereafter, 3 calendar years from
and including the day on which the previous election was completed.

17 Vacation of office

(1) A Councillor who –
(a) Resigns his seat by notice in writing to the Community
Development Officer;
(b) Is absent, without leave of the Council for 3 consecutive meetings
of the Council,
shall be deemed to have vacated his seat.
(2) The resignation of a Councillor takes effect on the date on which the
notice is received by the Community Development Officer.

18 Removal from office

(1) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Act, the Community
Development Officer shall, after due inquiry and after consultation, in such manner
as he thinks proper, with the Council, report the circumstances to the Secretary,
where he is satisfied that the Councillor has abused his powers or is incapable of
exercising them justly or is, for any other reason, not a fit and proper person to
continue to be a Councillor.
(2) The Secretary may suspend or remove from office any Councillor so
reported and suspension or removal from office shall take effect upon being notified
to the Council.
(3) The Secretary shall not remove a councillor from office under this section
unless the Councillor has been given reasonable opportunity of answering the
allegations made against him.

19 Casual vacancies

(1) Where a casual vacancy occurs, whether by reason of death, resignation
or otherwise, in an office of Councillor –
(a) If the vacancy occurs more than 6 months before the date upon
which the tenure of office of the former Councillor expires under
section 16, the vacancy shall be filled under section 15;
(b) In another case, the Community Development Officer may appoint
a person who is qualified to be a Councillor to hold the vacant office.
(2) A Councillor elected or appointed under this section shall hold office
for the balance of the tenure of office of the former Councillor.
PART 5
MEETINGS

20 Chairmen, Deputy Chairmen

(1) There shall be a Chairman and a Deputy Chairman of each Council
who shall be elected, as determined by the Council, by vote of the Councillors
from amongst their own number and may, in like manner, be removed from office.
1736 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(2) The person for the time being holding office as a member of the Assembly representing the constituency in which a Council has been established shall, in the event that he is not returned as a member in the Council election, be ex officio a member of that Council.

21 Standing Orders

Subject to this Act, a Council shall adopt Standing Orders which have the
prior approval of the Secretary covering –
(a) The calling, regulation, and conduct of the meetings of the Council;
(b) The custody of the common seal of the Council; and
(c) Such other matters as are necessary or convenient for the purposes
of this Act.

22 Meetings of Councils

(1) A Council shall meet not less frequently than once every month for the
transaction of general business, at such time and place as is determined by the
Council or, in the case of the first meeting of a Council after a Council election, by
the Community Development Officer.
(2) At any time after the first meeting following a general election the
Council Clerk shall call a special meeting if so requested by the Chairman or upon
the request of any 2 other members.
(3) Subject to the subsection (4), a meeting of a Council shall be open to the
public, unless the Council for any special reason otherwise resolves at the meeting.
(4) The Chairman of a meeting of a Council may –
(a) Exclude or require to withdraw from the meeting a person who, in
his opinion, is behaving in a disorderly manner; and
(b) Call upon any constable or a Council officer to eject any such person
refusing to withdraw from the meeting or any other person refusing
to withdraw in accordance with a resolution under subsection (3).

23 Chairman of meetings of Councils

(1) Subject to subsection (2), the Chairman, or in his absence the Deputy
Chairman, shall preside at all meetings of a Council.
(2) In the absence of the Chairman and the Deputy Chairman, the
Councillors present at a meeting of a Council shall elect one of their number to
preside for the purpose of that meeting.

24 Quorum and voting at meetings

(1) One half of the total membership of the Council, or 3 members,
whichever is the greater number, shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of
business at a meeting of a Council.
(2) Subject to subsection (3), all acts of a Council and all questions and
matters coming before a Council for decision shall be done and decided by a
majority of the Councillors present at the meeting and entitled to vote on it.
(3) The person presiding at a meeting of the Council shall have a
deliberative and, in the event of an equality of votes, a casting vote.

25 Minutes

Minutes of the proceedings of all meetings of a Council, including the names
of all Councillors present at any such meetings, shall be drawn up and entered in
a book to be kept for the purpose, and shall be signed at the next ensuing meeting
of the Council by the person presiding at that meeting.

Village Councils Act 1967

1737

26 Councillors not to vote on certain matters

(1) A Councillor who is a party to, or has a direct or indirect interest in, a
contract made by or on behalf of the Council under which goods or services are to
be supplied to the Council shall not take part in discussion on a matter, or vote on
a question, in the Council where the matter or question relates directly or indirectly
to the subject-matter of that contract.
(2) All questions concerning the application of subsection (1) shall be
decided by the Council and a contravention of that subsection does not affect the
validity of anything done by the Council.
PART 6
POWERS AND DUTIES OF COUNCILS

27 General functions of Councils

(1) In addition to any other powers, functions and duties conferred or
imposed on it by this Act and subject to any other law in force in Niue, a Council
may perform the functions specified in the Schedule.
(2) Cabinet may direct a Council to perform a function specified in the
Schedule, and it is the duty of the Council to comply with any such direction.
(3) Subject to this Act and to any other law in force in Niue, a Council may,
for the purposes of the exercise and performance of its powers, functions and
duties –
(a) Organise, finance, engage in or assist any business or enterprise; (b) Take such action as it deems desirable for the improvement of
standards of housing and of agricultural, pastoral, forestry,
horticultural or other methods and the economic or social
betterment of the Council area or of persons in it, including –
(i) the acquisition, by purchase, lease, or otherwise (but not
including compulsory acquisitions) of land and buildings;
(ii) the development or improvement of land;
(iii) the construction of buildings;
(iv) cooperation with the Government or other recognised authority
or body in the provision of credit facilities; and
(v) the acquisition or disposal of land or buildings;
(c) Carry out any works for the benefit of the Council area or of persons
there;
(d) Provide, or cooperate with the Government or other body in
providing, any public or social service;
(e) Do all such other matters and things as seem to it necessary or
desirable for carrying out and performing its other powers,
functions, duties and responsibilities, and any other matters and
things ancillary or incidental thereto.
(4) The exercise by a Council of a power conferred by subsection (4) shall
not be deemed to be invalid or unlawful merely because –
(a) It takes place outside the Council area or is related to matters outside
the Council area; or
(b) It is for the benefit of only some of the persons in the Council area
or is for the benefit of any such persons jointly with other persons;
if the consent of the Community Development Officer is obtained.
1738 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

28 Agency functions for Government

Subject to the approval of Cabinet, a Council may –
(a) Act as an agent of the Government, another Council or any other
public body or authority for the collection or payment of moneys
on such terms and conditions as to the payment of commission or
otherwise as are agreed on; and
(b) Perform and do such other acts, matters and things on behalf of the
Government, another Council or any other public body or authority
as are agreed, on such terms and conditions as are agreed on.

29 General power to make bylaws

Subject to this Act, Council may make bylaws, not inconsistent with this
Act, regulations, or any other law for the time being in force in Niue, for the purpose
of the exercise and performance of its powers, functions and duties.

30 Notice of bylaw

(1) A Council shall not, except with the consent of Cabinet, make a bylaw
unless reasonable notice of the intention to make the bylaw has first been given to
the Community Development Officer.
(2) Notice under subsection (1) shall be given in such manner as the
Community Development Officer directs.
(3) Failure to comply with this section does not invalidate a bylaw.

31 Assent to bylaws

No bylaw made under section 21 shall become effective until it has been
assented to in writing by Cabinet.

32 Model bylaws

Subject to this Act, the Community Development Officer may publish in
the Gazette model bylaws, which may be adopted with or without modification
by a Council.

33 Power to levy taxes

(1) Subject to subsections (2)-(4), a Council may, with the approval of
Cabinet, make bylaws imposing personal taxes, whether at flat rates or on
graduated scales (other than a tax based on income) on persons or classes of persons
resident within the Council area.
(2) Cabinet may, in relation to a Council, fix a maximum or maxima for
any tax or taxes imposed under subsection (1), subject to such conditions as Cabinet
thinks proper.
(3) Notwithstanding anything in this Act or in any other law in force in
Niue, a bylaw made under subsection (1) may provide for a reduction in the amount
of any tax payable if it is paid within a period limited by the bylaw, being a period
shorter than that otherwise provided for paying that tax.
(4) For the purposes of this section, a person shall be deemed to be a resident
of a Council area if he has his usual place of abode within that area, notwithstanding
his occasional absence from it or his occasional absence on leave from his
occupation or employment.

Village Councils Act 1967

1739

34 Review of taxes

(1) (a) There shall be a Tax Review Committee for each Council which
shall consist of the Community Development Officer together with
2 members of the Council, who shall be elected from among their
number;
(b) The elected members shall not be persons engaged in the collection
of taxes.
(2) On application from a taxpayer within 3 months of the tax becoming
payable a Tax Review Committee may grant an exemption from taxes on the
grounds of hardship or lack of sufficient means, or may on any ground reduce the
amount of tax payable by a person to such amount as to it seems proper.
(3) A person aggrieved by a decision of a Tax Review Committee under
subsection (2) may appeal to a Judge or Commissioner of the Court, who may
confirm, annul or vary the decision appealed against, and whose decision shall be
final.
(4) In any investigation and determination under this section by a Tax Review Committee, or in the hearing of an appeal under subsection (3), as the case may be, it shall not be necessary to observe strict legal procedure or to apply technical rules of evidence, but such relevant evidence as is available, including hearsay evidence, shall be admitted and considered.

35 Fees for services

A Council may, with the approval of the Community Development Officer,
by bylaw or otherwise, impose or charge fees for services supplied or rendered,
or to be supplied or rendered, by or on behalf of the Council.

36 Exemptions

A Council may, by bylaw, exempt in whole or in part, from the payment of
any tax or fee imposed under this Part any person the income of whom is exempt
from tax under the Income Tax Act 1961.

37 Recovery of taxes

Taxes or fees due to a Council under this Part may be recovered by the
Council as a debt.

38 Deposit accounts

PART 7
FINANCE
(1) Treasury shall open and maintain deposit accounts in the name of each Council established under this Act, and Councils shall pay into these accounts – (a) All moneys received from the Government for the purposes of this
Act;
(b) All moneys appropriated by Act for the purpose of carrying out or
giving effect to this Act;
(c) Taxes and fees, imposed or charged by the Council; and
(d) All other moneys received by the Council in or for the performance
or exercise of its functions, duties, or powers.
(2) A Council shall, out of the moneys standing to the credit of the account
referred to in subsection (1) pay –
(a) All money payable by the Council in repayment of advances under
this Act, and as interest, if any, on those advances;
(b) The costs, charges and expenses incurred by the Council in the
performance of its functions under this Act;
1740 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(c) The allowances, if any, of the Councillors;
(d) The remuneration of the Council Clerk and Officers and employees
of the Council; and
(e) Any other payment which the Council is authorised or required to
make by or under this Act or any other law in force in Niue.

39 Discretionary grants from public revenue

In addition to any other money which may be paid or advanced to or on
behalf of a Council, Cabinet may grant to a Council, upon such terms as it thinks
fit, any money appropriated by Act for the purpose.

40 Councils may accept offers by Cabinet to advance money

A Council may accept an offer by Cabinet to advance money for the
purposes of the Council on such terms as are agreed between the Council and
Cabinet.

41 Repayment of advances

A Council shall repay, in accordance with the terms under which the
advance is made, such portion of an advance as is repayable under these terms.

42 Borrowing

(1) A Council may, with the approval of the Community Development
Officer, borrow by means of overdraft or otherwise for the purposes of the Council
any sum not exceeding one half of the recurrent revenues of the Council during
the previous financial year as certified by the Auditor.
(2) For the purpose of the first financial year of the operation of a Council,
the limit fixed by the subsection (1) shall be deemed to be such limit as is fixed by
the Community Development Officer.

43 Estimates

(1) A Council shall, not later than 1 March each year, submit to the
Community Development Officer estimates of its receipts and expenditure during
the financial year next following, and may submit supplementary or revised
estimates.
(2) Where the Community Development Officer is satisfied that the
proposals contained in any estimates, supplementary estimates or revised estimates
are likely to be capable of being met from the finances available or likely to become
available for the purpose, he shall certify the estimates accordingly to the Council.
(3) Where the Community Development Officer is not satisfied as to the
matters referred to in subsection (2), he may, by notice to the Council, refuse
certification, in whole or in part, and shall immediately advise the Council of his
reasons for it.
(4) Where the Community Development Officer has withheld certification,
in whole or in part, of any estimates, the Council shall not incur expenditure,
collect revenue or commence or carry on any work or project in respect of the
whole or the part of the estimates of which certification has been withheld, without
the consent of the Community Development Officer.

Village Councils Act 1967

1741

44 Reserve Funds

(1) Subject to this section, a Council shall, unless otherwise authorised by
the Community Development Officer, set aside during each financial year not
less than one tenth of its recurrent revenue for that year as a reserve.
(2) A Council shall build up and maintain at all times a Reserve Fund equal
to 50 per centum of its average annual revenue over the 5 financial years
immediately preceding.
(3) When a Reserve Fund is built up under subsection (2), the provisions
of subsection (1) apply only to the extent necessary to maintain that Reserve Fund
at the level prescribed by subsection (2).

45 Power to invest

A Council may invest any moneys in the Reserve Fund –
(a) In any securities of, or guaranteed by, the Government of New
Zealand or the Government of Niue;
(b) On deposit in a bank;
(c) On any bonds issued under the Niue Development Bonds Act 1994;
or
(d) In any other manner approved by Cabinet.

46 Accounts

(1) A Council shall keep proper accounts and records under such
instructions as are issued by the Community Development Officer under
subsection (2) and shall do all things necessary to ensure that all payments out of
its funds are correctly made and properly authorised and that adequate control is
maintained over the assets of the Council and the incurring of liabilities by the
Council.
(2) The Community Development Officer may with the concurrence of
the Financial Secretary issue written instructions (Financial Memoranda), not
inconsistent with this Act and conforming with the principal provisions of the
Public Revenues Act 1959 and instructions issued under it for the better control
and management of the finance of Councils.
(3) Financial Memoranda shall be observed and obeyed by Councils,
Council Clerks and other Council officers.

47 Writing off irrecoverable amounts

A Council may, in such manner and subject to such conditions as may be
prescribed by instructions issued under section 46, write off –
(a) Losses or deficiencies from its funds;
(b) Irrecoverable amounts of revenue;
(c) Irrecoverable debts or overpayments; and
(d) The value of lost, deficient, condemned, unserviceable or obsolete
stores.

48 Audit

(1) A Council shall appoint a suitable person, approved by the Community
Development Officer, to be the Council Auditor.
(2) One person may be appointed to be the Council Auditor for more than
one Council.
(3) An Auditor shall or as required by the instruction issued under section
46, inspect and audit accounts and records of financial transactions of the Council
and shall forthwith draw the attention of the Council and the Community
1742 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
Development Officer to any irregularity revealed by the inspection and audit which, in the opinion of the Auditor, is of sufficient importance to justify his so doing.
(4) The Auditor shall, at least once in each year, report to the Council and the Community Development Officer the results of the inspection and audit carried out under subsection (3).
(5) The Council, a Councillor, Council Clerk, Council Officer or employee of the Council, shall, at all times, give an Auditor every possible assistance, including full and free access to all accounts, records, documents and papers, to enable him to carry out the inspection and audit.
(6) Every Council, Councillor, Council Clerk, Council Officer or employee who refuses to comply with any requirement of an Auditor under subsection (5), or who wilfully obstructs, hinders or resists an Auditor in the exercise of his powers and duties, commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

49 Suspension

PART 8
SUSPENSION AND DISSOLUTION
(1) Where the business of a Council is being so negligently, inefficiently or badly conducted as not to be for the welfare of the Council area and of persons in it or a Council is not properly carrying out the duties imposed on it by or under this Act or any other law in force in Niue, the Secretary may after receiving a report and recommendation accordingly from the Community Development Officer, by order in writing to the Chairman of the Council, suspend all or any of the powers and functions of that Council.
(2) A suspension under this section shall immediately be reported by the
Secretary to the Cabinet and, unless previously confirmed, varied or revoked by
Cabinet, shall lapse one month after the date of the suspension.
(3) A suspension under this section operates to deprive the Council of the
suspended powers or functions during the period of suspension, but does not
affect any right, privilege, obligation or liability acquired, accrued or incurred
under or in respect of the suspended power or function.

50 Appointment of Manager

(1) Where powers or functions of a Council are suspended under section
49, the Secretary, on the recommendation of the Community Development Officer,
may appoint a person to be Manager for the Council.
(2) Subject to any directions given by Cabinet, a Manager has and may
exercise on behalf of the Council such of the suspended powers and functions as
are specified by the Community Development Officer in writing to the Manager.
(3) Notwithstanding subsection (2), but subject to any directions given by
Cabinet, the Community Development Officer may exercise on behalf of the
Council during a suspension under section 49, all or any of the suspended powers
or functions.

51 Period of suspension

Subject to section 49(2) a suspension operates for such period as is fixed by
Cabinet for the purpose, or until the Council is abolished under section 52.

Village Councils Act 1967

1743

52 Abolition of Councils

(1) During a period of suspension under section 49 the Community
Development Officer may, with the concurrence of the Secretary, recommend to
Cabinet that a Council be abolished.
(2) Upon receipt of a recommendation under subsection (1) or of his own
motion, Cabinet may by notice published in the Gazette, abolish a Council.
(3) In a notice under subsection (2) or by a subsequent notice, Cabinet shall
appoint a person to be the Liquidator of the Council.
(4) A Liquidator shall proceed to wind up the affairs of the Council in
accordance with such directions as are given by the Community Development
Officer, and shall dispose of its assets in such manner as Cabinet determines.
(5) Upon the conclusion of the winding up and disposal of the affairs and
assets of a Council under subsection (4), the Liquidator shall make a report on it.
(6) Subject to this Act, upon the publication of a notice under subsection
(2) or on such later date as is specified in the notice, the powers and functions of
the Council cease and determine.

53 Council Clerks

PART 9
COUNCIL STAFF
(1) For each Council there may be appointed by the Niue Public Service Commission a Council Clerk and such other Council officers as may be necessary for the efficient performance of the functions and duties of the Council.
(2) Any person so appointed may hold office in addition to or in conjunction
with any office in the Niue Public Service.

54 Employees

In addition to officers appointed under section 53, a Council may employ
persons to render temporary or casual service to the Council on such terms and
conditions as are determined by the Council with the approval of the Community
Development Officer.
PART 10
OFFENCES

55 Failure to comply with rules

Any person who, without reasonable excuse (the proof of which excuse
shall be on him), contravenes or fails to comply with a bylaw made under this Act
and which is applicable to him, commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction
to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

56 Failure to pay taxes

(1) Any person liable to pay taxes under this Act who, without reasonable
cause, refuses or fails, after demand, whether oral or in writing, to pay the taxes at
or within the time prescribed in the bylaw imposing the tax, commits an offence
and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units or to
imprisonment for one month.
(2) In a prosecution under this section –
(a) Proof that a person has resided in the Council area or was enrolled
as an elector for the Council at any time during the period to which
the taxes relate is evidence that he resided in the Council area for
any period necessary for him to incur liability to pay the taxes; and
1744 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) The burden of proof –
(i) of reasonable cause within the meaning of subsection (1);
(ii) that the defendant has been exempted from the taxes payable
by him or the amount has been reduced under section 34;
(iii) of payment of the amount of the tax for which the defendant is
liable,
lies on the defendant.
(3) A conviction for an offence against subsection (1) does not relieve the
offender of the liability to pay the taxes.

57 Obstruction

(1) Any person who –
(a) Obstructs or interferes with the lawful exercise by a Council or the
Community Development Officer or an officer authorised by him,
or a Manager or Liquidator, of any of its or his powers or functions
under this Act or any other law in force in Niue; or
(b) Without lawful authority (the proof of which authority shall be on
him) purports to exercise any powers of a Council, or of a Councillor
or Council Officer, or of a Manager, Liquidator or Auditor,
commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit.
(2) Proceedings for an offence under subsection (1)(b) shall not be instituted
without the consent of the Community Development Officer.

58 Application of fines

All fines imposed for offences against this Act shall be paid to the Council
against which the offence was committed and shall form part of the Council
revenues.

59 Judicial notice

PART 11
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
(1) All Courts and persons acting judicially shall take judicial notice of – (a) All bylaws made by a Council; and
(b) Any act, matter or thing of which publication in the Gazette is
directed by or under this Act,
when so published.
(2) The common seals of all Councils shall be judicially and officially
noticed.

60 Public purposes

The purposes of Village Councils and the purposes of a Council shall be
deemed to be a public purpose within the meaning of any law in force in Niue.

61 Regulations

Cabinet may make regulations not inconsistent with this Act, prescribing
all matters which by this Act are required or permitted to be prescribed, or which
are necessary or convenient to be prescribed, for carrying out or giving effect to
this Act and in particular for providing for –
(a) Fees or allowances for Councillors;
(b) The regulation of the imposition and collection of taxes and fees by
Councils;

Village Councils Act 1967

1745
(c) The accounts and records to be kept by Councils; and
(d) The imposition of penalties not exceeding a fine of 0.5 penalty units
or imprisonment for one month, or both, for breaches of the
regulations.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE Section 27 (1) and (2)

General Functions of Councils

The undertaking, provision, construction, maintenance, management and regulation of –

1 Bush roads (excluding public roads).

2 Road cleaning (on behalf of land owners in the Council area, under section 82 of the Transport Act 1965).

3 Public parks, gardens, recreation areas, scenic resorts and lookouts, and other public places, reserves and land vested in the Council or placed under its control either permanently or temporarily, including –

(a) Bathing places; (b) Shelter sheds; (c) Public toilets.

4 Health, sanitation, prevention and suppression of infectious and other diseases, abatement of nuisances, disposal of the dead, including –

(a) Aid post, clinics, maternity and child welfare clinics; (b) Control of cemeteries;

(c) Public latrines and wash places;

(d) Prevention of pollution of water sources;

(e) Control of noxious animals, vermin and rodents;

(f) Village cleanliness.

5 Building and use and occupation of buildings, places of public amusement or public resort, stalls and stands on roads.

6 Markets and commercial enterprises including –

(a) Operation of Council markets and fixing maximum prices of commodities

sold in such markets;

(b) Supply of planting material.

7 Village planning, including –

(a) Schemes for any defined part or all of the Council area;

(b) Payment of compensation;

(c) Zoning schemes.

8 Housing schemes (acting in cooperation with the Assembly Housing Scheme).

1746 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

9 Public halls, public libraries and community centres, including –

(a) Adult education schemes (in cooperation with the Education Department

and Community Development Office);

(b) Equipment for recreational purposes;

(c) Grant sums of money to associations for the promotion of handicrafts,

recreation and sports, tourism, or the welfare of the people;

(d) The foundation, maintenance, operation and encouragement of social,

recreational, cultural and community centres and clubs for sporting, social

or other lawful purposes.

10 Supply of water, light and power, water conservation and storm water drainage, including –

(a) Entering into agreements with Government or with other Councils for such purposes;

(b) Establishment and maintenance of forest plantations and natural forest reserves;

(c) Regulating the use of public water supplies; (d) Establishing lighting in public places.

11 Pounds and impounding of animals.

12 Establishment and maintenance of fish ponds.

13 Agricultural, pastoral, horticultural and forestry industries and the economic use of Niuean customary land, including requiring the owners of land to cultivate it to such extent and with such crops as will ensure a sufficient supply of food for their support and the support of those dependent upon them.

14 Omnibus and transport services.

15 Construction and maintenance of sea approaches.

16 Protection of fish resources under Domestic Fishing Act 1995, and flora and fauna.

17 Prescribe the duties and functions of any person employed by the Council in connection with any function of the Council.

1747

VISITING FORCES ACT 1939

1939/36 (NZ) – 30 August 1940

1

Short title

5

Deserters from overseas forces

2

Interpretation

6

[Repealed]

3

Discipline and internal administration of

7

Application of Act

visiting forces

8

[Repealed]

4

Relations of visiting forces to the civil

9

Limitation of penalties

power and civilians

10

Regulations

To make provision with respect to forces of Her Majesty from other parts of the Commonwealth or from a colony when visiting New Zealand, and with respect to the exercise of command and discipline when forces of Her Majesty from different parts of the Commonwealth are serving together, and with respect to the attachment of members of one such force to another such force, and with respect to deserters from such forces

1 Short title

This is the Visiting Forces Act 1939.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“court” includes a service court of inquiry and any officer of a visiting
force who is empowered by the law of that part of the Commonwealth
to which the force belongs to review the proceedings of a service court,
or to investigate charges, or himself to dispose of charges; and
“sentence” shall be construed accordingly;
“forces” includes reserve and auxiliary forces;
“home forces” means the naval, military and air forces of Her Majesty raised
in New Zealand; and “home force” includes any body, contingent, or
detachment of any of the home forces, wherever serving;
“internal administration”, in relation to any visiting force, includes the
administration of the property of a deceased member of the force;
“member”, in relation to a visiting force, includes any person who is by
law of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force belongs subject
to the naval, military, or air force law of the part of the Commonwealth
and who, being a member of another force, is attached to the visiting
force or, being a civilian employed in connection with the visiting force,
entered into the engagement outside New Zealand;
“part of the Commonwealth” means any country which Cabinet by
regulation declares to be part of the Commonwealth for the purposes
of this Act;
“visiting force” means any body, contingent, or detachment of the naval,
military, or air forces of any part of the Commonwealth which is, with
the consent of the Niue Government, lawfully present in Niue.
1748 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

3 Discipline and internal administration of visiting forces

(1) When a visiting force is present in Niue it shall be lawful for the naval,
military, and air force courts and authorities (the “service courts” and the “service
authorities”) of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force belongs to
exercise within Niue in relation to members of such force in matters concerning
discipline and in matters concerning the internal administration of such force all
such powers as are conferred upon them by the law of that part of the
Commonwealth.
(2) The members of any such service court as aforesaid exercising
jurisdiction by virtue of this Act, and witnesses appearing before any such court,
shall enjoy the like immunities and privileges as are enjoyed by a service court
exercising jurisdiction by virtue of any enactment in force in New Zealand and by
witnesses appearing before such a court.
(3) (a) Where any sentence has, whether within or without Niue, been
passed upon a member of a visiting force by a service court of that
part of the Commonwealth to which the force belongs, then for the
purposes of any legal proceedings within Niue the court shall be
deemed to have been properly constituted, and its proceedings shall
be deemed to have been regularly conducted, and the sentence shall
be deemed to be within the jurisdiction of the court and under the
law of that part of the Commonwealth and, if executed according
to its tenor, shall be deemed to have been lawfully executed, and
any member of a visiting force who is detained in custody in
pursuance of any such sentence, or pending the determination by
such a service court as aforesaid of a charge brought against him,
shall for the purposes of any such proceedings as aforesaid be
deemed to be in lawful custody.
(b) For the purposes of any such proceedings as aforesaid a certificate
under the hand of the officer commanding a visiting force that a
member of that force is being detained for either of the causes
aforesaid shall be conclusive evidence of the cause of his detention,
but not of his being such a member, and a certificate under the hand
of such an officer that the persons specified in the certificate sat as
a service court of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force
belongs shall be conclusive evidence of that fact.
(4) No proceedings in respect of the pay, terms of service, or discharge of a
member of a visiting force shall be entertained by any court of Niue.
(5) For the purpose of enabling such service courts and such service
authorities to exercise more effectively the powers conferred upon them by this
section, Cabinet, if so requested by the officer commanding a visiting force or by
the Government of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force belongs,
may by general or special orders to any home force, direct the members of it to
arrest members of the visiting force alleged to have been guilty of offences against
the law of that part of the Commonwealth, and to hand over any person so arrested
to the appropriate authorities of the visiting force.

4 Relations of visiting forces to the civil power and civilians

(1) (a) Cabinet may by regulation authorise any Government department,
Minister of the Crown, or other person in Niue to perform, at the
request of such authority or officer as may be specified in the order,
but subject to such limitations as may be so specified, any function
in relation to a visiting force and members of it which that

Visiting Forces Act 1939

1749
Department, Minister, or person performs or could perform in relation to a home force of like nature to the visiting force, or in relation to members of such a force, and for the purpose of the exercise of any such function any power exercisable by virtue of any enactment by the Department, Minister, or person in relation to a home force or members of it shall be exercisable in relation to the visiting forces and members of it.
(b) Nothing in this subsection shall authorise any interference in matters relating to discipline or to the internal administration of the force.
(2) [Repealed by 2004/270]
(3) If Cabinet by regulation so provides, members of a visiting force if
sentenced by a service court of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force
belongs to penal servitude, imprisonment, or detention may, under the authority
of Cabinet, given at the request of the officer commanding the visiting force, be
temporarily detained in custody in prisons or detention barracks in Niue; and, if
so sentenced to imprisonment, may, under the like authority, be imprisoned during
the whole or any part of the term of their sentences in prisons in Niue, and Cabinet
may by regulation make provision with respect to any of the following matters –
(a) The reception of such persons from, and their return to, the service
authorities concerned;
(b) Their treatment while in such custody or while so imprisoned;
(c) The circumstances under which they are to be released; and
(d) The manner in which they are to be dealt with in the event of their
unsoundness of mind while in such custody, or while so imprisoned.
(4) Any costs incurred in the maintenance and return of or otherwise in
connection with any person dealt with under subsection (3) shall be defrayed in
such manner as may with the approval of the Minister of Finance be agreed between
the Minister of Defence and the Government of that part of the Commonwealth
which is concerned.
(5) Subject to this subsection and subsection (6), any enactment in force in
Niue which –
(a) Exempts, or provides for the exemption of, any vessel, vehicle,
aircraft, machine, or apparatus of or employed for the purposes of
the home forces or any of them from the operation of any enactment;
or
(b) In virtue of a connection with the home forces, or any of them,
confers a privilege or immunity on any person; or
(c) In virtue of such a connection excepts any property, trade, or
business, in whole or in part, from the operation of any enactment,
or from any tax, rate, imposition, toll, or charge; or
(d) Imposes upon any person or undertaking obligations in relation to
the home forces, or any of them, or any member or service court; or
(e) Penalises misconduct by any person in relation to the home forces,
or any of them, or any member or service court –
shall, with any necessary modifications, apply in relation to a visiting force as it
would apply in relation to a home force of a like nature of the visiting force.
(6) Regulations made under this section may apply either generally or in
relation to visiting forces from any particular part of the Commonwealth, or in
relation to any particular visiting force, or in relation to any particular place.
1750 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

5 Deserters from overseas forces

(1) The forces to which this section applies are such of the naval, military,
and air forces of any part of the Commonwealth as Cabinet may by regulation
direct.
(2) Subject to this section, the law in force in Niue relating to the apprehension of deserters and absentees without leave from a home force shall within Niue apply in relation to a deserter or an absentee without leave from any force to which this section applies (including any member of a reserve or auxiliary force who, having failed to obey a notice calling upon him to appear at any place for service, is by the law of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force belongs, liable to the same punishment as a deserter, or to the same punishment as an absentee without leave), as they apply in relation to a deserter or absentee without leave from a home force.
(3) (a) No person who is alleged to be a deserter from any such force as aforesaid shall be apprehended or dealt with under this section except in compliance with a specific request from the Government of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force belongs, and a person so dealt with shall be handed over to the authorities of that part of the Commonwealth at such place in Niue as may be agreed.
(b) A person who is alleged to be a deserter or absentee without leave
from a visiting force may also be apprehended and dealt with under
this section in compliance with a request, whether specific or
general, from the officer commanding that force, and shall, if that
force is still present in Niue, be handed over to the officer
commanding that force at the place where the force is stationed.
(4) For the purposes of any proceedings under this section –
(a) A document purporting to be a certificate of Cabinet or of a
prescribed officer that a request has been made under subsection
(3) shall be admissible without proof as evidence of such a request;
(b) A document purporting to be a certificate under the hand of the
officer commanding a unit or detachment of any force to which
this section applies that a named and described person was at the
date of the certificate a deserter, or absentee without leave, from
that force shall be admissible without proof as evidence of the facts
so certified.

6 [Repealed by 2004/270]

7 Application of Act

Subject to such exemptions, adaptations, and modifications as Cabinet may
by regulation direct –
(a) This Act shall apply in relation to any naval, military, or air forces
raised in any territory for whose international relations the
Government of any part of the Commonwealth is responsible, as if
those forces were part of the naval, military, or air forces of that
part of the Commonwealth;
(b) This Act shall apply in relation to any naval, military, or air forces
raised in the Cook Islands, Niue, or Tokelau as if those forces were part of the
home forces.

8 [Repealed by 2004/270]

Visiting Forces Act 1939

1751

9 Limitation of penalties

Nothing in this Act shall be construed to authorise any service court of any
part of the Commonwealth to impose on a member of a visiting force in respect of
any offence any penalty exceeding the penalty to which a member of the home
forces would under the law of Niue be liable for a similar offence.

10 Regulations

Cabinet may make such regulations, not inconsistent with this Act, as may
be deemed necessary or convenient for the purpose of giving full effect to this
Act.

1752 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1753

WATER RESOURCES ACT 1996

1996/209 – 20 August 1996

PART 1 PART 5

PRELIMINARY USE OF BORES

1 Short title 17 Extraction licences

2 Interpretation 18 Waste disposal licences

3 Act to bind the Crown 19 Change in use of bore

4 Purpose of legislation 20 Amendment of licences

5 Cabinet may resolve disputes 21 Cancellation of licences

6 Cabinet may make dispensations

7 Vesting of ground water in the Crown PART 6

WATER SUPPLY

PART 2 22 Power to supply water

GENERAL POWERS OF MANAGER 23 Power to install meters

8 Responsibilities of Manager 24 Power to disconnect supplies

9 Power to enter and use lands 25 Power to suspend supplies

10 Power for entering land and premises 26 Powers of the Health Officer

11 Power to impose restrictions

12 Power to make water conservation orders PART 7

13 Power to charge fees REGULATIONS

27 General Regulations

PART 3

GROUND WATER INVESTIGATION PROGRAMME PART 8

14 Manager may conduct programme MISCELLANEOUS

15 Power to require samples 28 Personal liability of officers

29 Offences

PART 4 30 Penalties

CONSTRUCTION OF BORES 31 Compensation

16 Power to construct bores 32 [Repealed]

To make provision for the investigation, use, control, protection and management of water

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
This is the Water Resources Act 1996.

2 Interpretation

(1) In this Act and any Regulation made under it –
“bore” means any bore, well, gallery, cave or drive or any artificially
constructed or improved underground cavity;
“Crown land” means Crown land as defined in section 2 of the Niue
Amendment Act (No 2) 1968;
1754 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
“environment” includes all aspects of the surroundings of man, whether affecting him as an individual or in his social groupings and shall include biological, social and aesthetic factors of those surroundings;
“groundwater” means any water occurring in or obtained from any geological structure or formation permeated or capable of being permeated usually or occasionally with water and includes any matter dissolved or suspended in such water;
“Health Officer” means Public Health Officer or a person authorised in writing on his behalf;
“Manager” means the Director of Works or the Water Manager (Water
Resources) is appointed;
“meter” means any device approved by the Manager for measuring the
amount of water extracted or used or the rate at which it is extracted or
used and includes such fittings and ancillary equipment as may be
necessary or desirable to so measure;
“pollution” means any direct or indirect alteration of the physical, thermal,
chemical, biological or radioactive properties of any water so as to
render such water less fit for any beneficial purpose for which it is, or
may reasonably be used, or to cause a condition which is hazardous or
potentially hazardous to public health, safety or welfare, or to animals,
birds, wildlife, fish or aquatic life, or to plants;
“premises” includes any structure, building or part of building or land
with or without buildings;
“private” in the expressions “private water works” and “private sewerage
works” shall include any works owned or operated by any person, or
Village Council other than a Public Authority, and or the Manager;
“private water works” shall include roofing, spouting, downpipes, rain
water holding tank, piping and taps of it. The pipes and all fittings
which extend from the main public water supply pipe to the premises
of it;
“private sewerage works” shall include the soak hole disposal trench,
disposal mound (to cover other possible effluent disposal methods)
septic tank, vents, drain pipes, toilet pan, sink, shower, wash and hand
basins;
“public water supply” means any waterworks constructed or operated by
the Manager for the purpose of supplying water under section 22;
“public authority” includes any Government department or an officer of
the Niue Public Service and any statutory body, statutory corporation
or officer of it;
“sewerage” means any matter, or any water contaminated by any matter
in solution or suspension or carried along, as is derived from the use of
water in connection with the life or vocations of mankind;
“sewerage works” includes all sewers, pipes, conduits, tanks, receptacles
or other appliances and any works incidental there to be used or
intended to be used for the reception, discharge, retention, removal,
treatment or disposal of sewage;
“Village Council” means any Village Council established under the Village
Councils Act;
“water” includes all groundwater, cave waters, seawater and rainwater;
“water works” includes any bores, catchments, reservoirs, tanks, cisterns,
conduits, mains, pipes, meters, valves, hydrants, pumps, engines and
all other structures or appliances used or constructed for the storage,
treatment, conveyance, supply, measurement or regulation of water.

Water Resources Act 1996

1755
(2) Subject to subsection (1), words, phrases, and expressions used in this Act and defined in the Constitution or the Land Act 1969 shall, unless a contrary intention appears, have in this Act and Regulations made under it, the meaning so defined.
under this Act shall have regard to the need to make proper provision for –
(a) Adequate supplies of suitable water for domestic use, for the
watering of animals, for irrigation and agricultural purposes, for
rural, commercial, industrial use, and for recreation;
(b) Adequate facilities for drainage, the safe disposal of sewage, effluent
and water-borne wastes and the control and prevention of pollution
and disease;
(c) The protection of natural or artificial sources of water from excessive
or improper use, from the intrusion of saline water and from
pollution and other damage;
(d) Procedures to ensure that the possible consequences of particular
development proposals on the environment are properly
investigated and considered before such proposals are approved
and are properly monitored thereafter;
(e) Procedures to facilitate and ensure the coordination of all detailed
planning for the investigation, use, control, protection, management
and administration of water resources; and
(f) Procedures to facilitate and ensure the coordinated execution of
approved plans and projects by public authorities.

5 Cabinet may resolve disputes

Subject to this Act, the Cabinet, on the application of the Manager or the
Health Officer shall have power to resolve any conflict in the powers of, or any
disputes between, any public authorities relating to any matter concerning the
investigation, use, control, protection, management or administration of water or
any powers conferred by this Act or its Regulations.

6 Cabinet may make dispensations

The Cabinet may, on the joint recommendation of the Manager and the
Health Officer, exempt any bored, proposed bore or class of bores from any of the
requirements of this Act or of any Regulations made hereunder as long as it does
not compromise any health or environmental requirements.
1756 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

7 Vesting of ground water in the Crown

The right to the use, flow, pipe, store, sale and control to all ground water is
vested in the Crown.
PART 2
GENERAL POWERS OF MANAGER

8 Responsibilities of Manager

(1) The Manager shall be responsible to the Minister of Works and subject
to this Act, be responsible for –
(a) The investigation and exploration of groundwater resources and
the collection of data and dissemination of information relating to
it;
(b) The management, conservation, protection and replenishment of
water resources;
(c) The construction, alteration, repair and maintenance of bores;
(d) The licensing, inspection, oversight and control of the extraction
and use of water from any bore;
(e) The temporary or permanent shutting down or sealing of any bore;
(f) The design, construction, operation, repair, maintenance,
management, control and administration of all public water supplies
and of all water works comprising such supplies;
(g) The management, protection and treatment by chemicals or by other
means of all water contained in such water works, provided that
the Manager shall not so treat any such water without the prior
consent of the Health Officer as provided for in this Act;
(h) The distribution and sale of water from any public water supply;
(i) The collection of any fees, charges, or rates which may be imposed
or levied in connection with the construction, alteration, repair or
maintenance of any bore, any licence for the extraction of water or
disposal of wastes, or any public water supply;
(j) The carrying out of this Act and any Regulations made under it.
(2) The Manager shall have all powers necessarily incidental to it.

9 Power to enter and use lands

(1) The Manager, or any person duly authorised by him and, in the case of
paragraphs (b), (d), (e), (f) and (g), the Health Officer, or any person duly authorised
by him may enter upon and use any lands at any time for the purpose of –
(a) Carrying out any surveys, including geological and groundwater
surveys, necessary for the exploration or investigation of
groundwater resources or the collection of data relating to it;
(b) Carrying out any site investigations; including the carrying out
pumping tests or any other activity whatsoever as is necessary for
the exploration or investigation of groundwater resources;
(c) Carrying out or erecting on it such works or buildings, or depositing
on it such material, or erecting such pumps or other equipment for
the purpose of exploration or investigation of groundwater
resources, or for the purpose of constructing, altering, repairing or
maintaining any bore;
(d) Inspecting or monitoring the use of any bore and the taking of
samples of water extracted there from in it;
(e) The shutting down or sealing or opening of any bore;

Water Resources Act 1996

1757
(f) Assessing the need to make any order under section 12 or whether such order is being or has been carried out, or for carrying out any work authorised by that section;
(g) Erecting rain gauges or other instruments for the purposes of collecting hydrometeorological data;
(h) Carrying out any survey necessary for the design, construction or
maintenance of water works and public water supplies;
(i) Laying any main, connection, or pipes through, across, or under
any land or road;
(j) Inspecting, repairing, maintaining, renewing, altering, removing
or testing any main, connection or pipes;
(k) Erecting on it such temporary works or buildings, or depositing on
it such materials as may be necessary for the laying, inspecting,
repairing, maintaining, renewing, altering, removing or testing of
any main, connection pipes or any other water works;
(l) Taking, in any emergency situation, such action as he deems
necessary for the proper conservation and protection of
groundwater resources:
Provided that no entry shall be made under this section to any land unless verbal
or written notice has first been given to the occupier of it.
(2) Where the land is expressly required for a bore site the Manager must
consult with the Leviki of the land and seek written agreement for the proposed
site for the water bore.

10 Power for entering land and premises

(1) The Manager, or any person duly authorised by him and, in the case of
subsection (2), the Health Officer, or any person duly authorised by him may enter upon any land and or premises –
(a) Into or upon which any service is being or has been laid for the
supply of water from any water works associated with a public
water supply;
(i) To inspect any service and ascertain whether there is any
wastage, leakage, obstruction, alteration, interference, or
damage to any service or meter in it and to do anything in
connection therewith;
(ii) To regulate or repair any service or meter;
(iii) To ascertain the consumption of any water supplied;
(iv) To disconnect the service to any premises;
(v) To suspend, stop or turn off the supply of water to any premises
either wholly or in part in order to carry out any of the powers
of the Manager under this Act;
(b) To cut and remove on either side of any works, whether existing or
proposed, for a distance indicated in the Regulations, any
undergrowth, trees or part of any tree including their roots which
may interfere or may be likely to interfere with any works;
(c) Should any tree growing on any land cause or likely to cause
damage to any works, the Manager may cause notice to be given to
the owner of such land to remove the said tree or part of it and
should the owner fail to comply with the terms of such notice within
the time specified therein (being not less than 7 clear days after the
time of the service of that notice), the Manager may enter upon that
land and remove the tree or any part of it but so that no unnecessary
damage is done or incurred by it.
1758 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(d) If the rights conferred by paragraph (b) shall have been exercised in respect of any land no compensation shall be paid in respect of any tree or part of it on such land and cut under the powers conferred by this section;
(e) For the purposes of inspecting any private water works or private sewerage works or for assessing the need to make an order under section 12 or whether such order is being or has been carried out or for carrying out any work authorised by that section.
(2) Except in the case of drought, cyclone, earthquake, or any other
emergency, the powers conferred by this section may only be exercised during
daylight hours and on informing the occupier if possible.

11 Power to impose restrictions

The Manager may, in times of actual or anticipated shortage of water, by
notification over television and or radio and or in any newspaper circulating on
Niue, shall monitor –
(a) The amount of water which may be extracted or maximum rate at
which water may be extracted from any bore, water reservoir, or
main pipe line;
(b) The amount of waste which may be disposed of, or the maximum
rate at which waste may be disposed of, and any person, public
authority or Village Council to whom a licence has been issued
under this Act shall thereupon observe the restrictions contained
in any such notice and the terms of any such notice shall be deemed
to be a condition of any licence in force under this Act for the period
specified in the notice or until such notice is revoked.

12 Power to make water conservation orders

(1) Notwithstanding any other provision of this Act or any other legislation,
where the Manager or the Public Health Inspector is satisfied that any act or
omission by any person or public authority or Village Council may result, directly
or indirectly, in the pollution or deterioration, inequitable distribution, loss, wastage
or undue depletion of any water, the Manager may by order direct any person,
public authority or Village Council, or the owner or occupier of any land, to do
any one or more of the following –
(a) To close and shut off the supply of water from any bore, public
water supply or private water works;
(b) To restrict or limit the amount of water taken from any bore, public
water supply or private water works;
(c) To discontinue the use of any bore or any public water supply,
private water works or private sewerage works or any water works
associated with it or connected to it;
(d) To treat any sewage or waste in a manner specified in the order;
(e) To prevent the amount of waste entering any ground water, sea or
cave in the manner specified in the order;
(f) To use the water extracted from any bore for such purposes as may
be specified in the order;
(g) To treat any water extracted from any bore or contained in any public
water supply or private water supply in such manner as may be
specified in the order;
(h) To do, cease or to refrain from doing any act or thing on any land or
to do such act or thing which could or may be likely to harm Niue’s
water lens, storage or supply, which shall be specified in the order;

Water Resources Act 1996

1759
(i) To erect such structures or to carry out such works, including water works or sewerage works, or to repair, maintain, alter or remove such structures or works as may be specified in the order.
(2) (a) In any case where the Public Health Inspector is satisfied that any act or omission by any person or Public Authority may result in, directly or indirectly, the likely pollution or deterioration of Niue’s water lens, any water supply or in any threat to public health, or our environment he shall exercise any of the powers granted by the previous subsection;
(b) The Health Officer shall not issue an order with respect to any bore or public water supply under the control of the Manager without prior consultation with the Manager.
(3) If any person, public authority, Village Council or the owner or occupier of any land to whom an order under this section is addressed shall fail to comply with any direction contained in such order within such time as is specified in the order, the Manager or, in the case of an order issued under subsection (2), either the Manager or the Health Officer, may cause the provisions of the order to be carried out and may recover any expenses incurred from the person, public authority, Village Council or owner or occupier of land to whom the order was addressed.

13 Power to charge fees

(1) Subject to any regulations made hereunder, the Manager with approval
of Cabinet may impose fees or charges for the doing of any act, the considering of
any application or the issuing of any licence or approval under this Act and may
impose and collect fees, charges and rates –
(a) On any person, public authority or Village Council who extracts
any water or disposes of any waste under a licence granted under
this Act;
(b) On any person, public authority or Village Council served by the
construction, alteration, repair, maintenance or operation of any bore
or any public water supply;
(c) On any person, public authority or Village Council to whom the
Manager supplies or sells any water under this Act.
(2) Subject to subsection (1) the Public Health Inspector may impose fees
or charges for the inspection of any bore or any public or private water supply or
sewerage works and for the sampling and testing of any water or waste.
PART 3
GROUNDWATER INVESTIGATION PROGRAMME

14 Manager may conduct programme

(1) The Manager may cause a programme of investigation into
groundwater resources to be prepared.
(2) The programme may provide for the collection, collation and analysis
of data concerning in particular –
(a) The location, pressure, composition and movement of groundwater;
(b) The properties of groundwater or of the rock or coral containing
groundwater or through which such groundwater percolates;
(c) Any other matters in connection with the availability of
groundwater or its suitability for use or its protection from
depletion, wastage or pollution or its replenishment.
(3) The Manager may do anything necessary or expedient for or in
connection with the carrying out of the programme.
1760 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

15 Power to require samples

The Manager may require any person who is the holder of any licence issued
under the Mining Act 1977 to supply the Manager with such samples from the
core or water of any bore constructed under such licence and any details concerning
such bore and the operation of it as the Manager may require.
PART 4
CONSTRUCTION OF BORES

16 Power to construct bores

(1) No person other than the Manager or public authority shall construct,
alter, repair or maintain any bore for the purpose of extracting water or cause any
such bore to be constructed, altered, repaired or maintained.
(2) The Manager may, with the consent of the Health Officer as to the
proposed location of it, construct any bore for the extraction of water for the
purposes of Part 6.
(3) Any person, public authority or Village Council may apply to the
Manager to have a proposed bore constructed or any bore altered in the manner
provided for in Regulations made hereunder.
(4) The Manager, with the consent of the Health Officer, may grant such
application subject to such terms and conditions as he thinks fit or as are provided
for in Regulations made hereunder or may refuse to grant such application.
(5) Where any person holding a licence under Part 4 of the Mining Act
1977 has constructed or proposes to construct a bore which has encountered or
may encounter any groundwater, the Manager may require such precautions to
be taken or work to be done in relation to such bore as he deems necessary for the
protection of such groundwater and may exercise the powers conferred by section
12 in relation to any such bore.

17 Extraction licences

PART 5
USE OF BORES
bore.
(1) Only the Manager may extract and use supply and sell water from any
(2) No use of water or natural depositories of water by any person or public
authority holding a licence under Part 4 of the Mining Act 1977 shall be deemed lawful.
(3) No person or public authority shall cause or permit any water to be extracted or used from any bore except as authorised by the Manager and under the conditions of an extraction licence issued under this section.

18 Waste disposal licences

(1) Any person or public authority wishing to dispose of any matter
underground shall apply to the Manager for a licence in the manner provided for
in regulations under this Act.
(2) The Manager shall with the consent of the Health Officer grant such
application subject to such conditions as the Manager and the Health Officer shall
jointly think fit or as are provided for in regulations made hereunder, or may
refuse to grant such application.
(3) The Manager shall not approve an application in respect of any disposal
which in his opinion or in the opinion of the Health Officer would or maybe or is
likely to cause the pollution of any groundwater or be detrimental to any bore.
(4) No person or public authority shall cause or permit any matter to be
disposed of underground by means of a water bore.

Water Resources Act 1996

1761

19 Change in use of bore

(1) Any person or public authority wishing to change the purpose for which
any bore is used shall apply to the Manager for approval in the manner provided
for in Regulations under this Act.
(2) The Manager shall, with the consent of the Health Officer grant such
application subject to such conditions as the Manager and the Health Officer shall
jointly think fit or as are provided for in Regulations made hereunder, or may
refuse to grant such applications.
(3) As a condition of granting any such application the Manager may
require any applicant to apply for and obtain a licence under section 17 or section
18.
(4) No person or public authority or any person who has constructed a bore under a licence granted under Part 4 of the Mining Act 1977 shall change the purpose for which any bore is used unless approval has been obtained under this section.

20 Amendment of licences

(1) The Manager may amend any licence granted under sections 17 and 18
and may add to, vary or contradict the conditions of any licence, notwithstanding
that such conditions are prescribed by Regulations under this Act.
(2) The Manager shall not amend any licence or add to, vary or contradict
the conditions of any licence granted under section 18, 19 or which would harm
Niue’s water lens, without the prior consent of the Public Health Inspector.

21 Cancellation of licences

The Manager may cancel or suspend any licence for breach of any of the
conditions contained in it or breach of any of the provisions of this Act or of any
regulations made hereunder.

22 Power to supply water

PART 6
WATER SUPPLY
(1) The Manager may, subject to this Act, extract and collect from any bore constructed for the purpose of supplying water, and may store, supply and sell any such water to any person, Public Authority or any Village Council.
(2) The Manager shall not be obliged to supply or sell water to any person, public authority or any Village Council and may refuse the supply of it to any person, public authority or Village Council if any rates or charges have not been paid.
(3) The Manager and staff are not liable for failure of the Public Water Supply, and no claim can be made against the Water and Waste Utility, Manager or his staff.

23 Power to install meters

The Manager may install meters for the purpose of measuring any water
supplied or sold under this Act, but the Manager shall not be obliged to install
such meters, and where water is supplied without any meter being installed, the
measurement of water supplied shall be calculated by such means as the Manager
may provide.
1762 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

24 Power to disconnect supplies

The Manager may disconnect the supply of water to any person, public
authority or Village Council where –
(a) Any deposit or advance payment required by the Manager has not
been paid;
(b) Where the payment of any fee, charge or rate made or levied under
this Act is in arrears;
(c) Where, in the opinion of the Manager any person consuming water
from that supply allows or has allowed any water from that supply
to run to waste;
(d) Where any person, public authority or Village Council is in breach
of the conditions of any agreement under which water is supplied,
or has failed to comply with this Act or Regulations made hereunder;
(e) Where any person, public authority or Village Council is in breach
of any order issued under section 12 or of the provisions of this Act
or any regulations made under it.

25 Power to suspend supplies

The Manager may restrict, suspend or stop the supply of water under section
22 to any public or private water works –
(a) Whenever, in the opinion of the Manager, there is an actual or
anticipated shortage of water available;
(b) Whenever it may be expedient or necessary for the purposes of
extending, altering, testing, treating, maintaining or repairing the
water works or for the purposes of the connection of services or for
the fighting of fires;
(c) Whenever any water works are damaged or waters are polluted or
wasted;
(d) Whenever there is any breakdown in the water works.

26 Powers of the Health Officer

Where is of the opinion that any water contained in any bore, public water
supply is likely or may become polluted or there is likely or may be a threat to
public health, the Health Officer, after consultation with the Manager and, where
appropriate, with any person, public authority or Village Council –
(a) May require the Manager to restrict, suspend or stop the supply of
water to any person, public authority or Village Council;
(b) May treat or require the Manager to treat any water contained in
any water works associated with such supply;
and the Manager shall forthwith comply with such requirement.

27 General Regulations

PART 7
REGULATIONS
The Cabinet may make regulations for the purpose of carrying out this Act and, without in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing, may make regulations;
(a) Prescribing the mode, form, strength and material of construction of and the depth, dimensions, arrangement and positioning of bores and ancillary works;
(b) Prescribing standards for the construction, renewal, alteration, repair and maintenance of any bore;

Water Resources Act 1996

1763
(c) Regulating the operation of bores and ancillary works so as to prevent the waste, misuse or pollution of any groundwater;
(d) Prohibiting the doing of acts or things which may result in the pollution of any water;
(e) Prescribing standards and procedures for the sampling and setting aside of any material, water or other fluid extracted or taken in any way whatsoever from any bore;
(f) Fixing, in times of actual or anticipated shortage of water, the amount of water which may be taken or maximum rate at which water may be taken from any bore or types of bore.
(g) Fixing the times at which water may be taken from any bore or types of bore;
(h) Temporarily or permanently prohibiting the taking or use of water from any bore;
(i) Prescribing forms for use under this Act;
(j) Concerning the issue, renewal, transfer, cancellation, revocation,
suspension and variation of licences and approvals and the making,
amendment or alteration of any order under this Act;
(k) Prescribing conditions or classes of conditions which may be
attached to licence or approvals issued under this Act or to the sale
of any water from any public water supply;
(l) Specifying standards of quality and means to be adopted for the
purification or protection of any water and the protection of any
land adjacent to any bore;
(m) Specifying, appointing, and empowering responsible authorities
to exercise any powers or functions under this Act or any regulations
made hereunder;
(n) Prescribing fees, charges and rates to be made under this Act;
(o) Prescribing the procedure to be adopted in the application and
collection of such fees, charges and rates;
(p) Regulating and controlling the planning, construction, operation,
repair or maintenance of any public water supply;
(q) Prescribing the nature and strength of materials used, the size,
position and arrangement and method of connection of, and the
workmanship and standard of any fittings to be used in, any public
or private water supply, water works or sewerage works and also
the type, nature and method of connection of any apparatus for the
storage or use of water on any premises for any purposes
whatsoever, including the method of disposal and treatment of any
waste therefrom;
(r) Examining, licencing and authorising any person to construct,
renew, alter, repair maintain any public or private water supply,
water works, or sewerage works connected to it;
(s) Prescribing the situations in which and methods by which
restrictions on the use of water from any water works may be
imposed;
(t) Regulating the acquisitions, disposition, custody, inspection, testing,
maintenance and protection from alteration or damage of any meter
or other measuring device;
(u) Specifying acts or omissions contrary to the purposes of this Act
which shall be regarded as offences against this Act and, subject to
section 30, fixing penalties in relation to it;
1764 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(v) Any matter concerning the investigation, use, control, protection, management or administration of water resources;
(w) Any matter necessary or convenient to the carrying out or giving effect to, to forming of a company or corporatisation and other matters of this Act.
PART 8
MISCELLANEOUS

28 Personal liability of officers

No person shall be personally liable for any act done by him in good faith
in the exercise of any duties, powers, or authorities imposed or conferred on him
by this Act.

29 Offences

(1) Any person who assaults, resists, obstructs, hinders or delays or who
entices or encourages any other person to assault, resist, hinder obstruct or delay
any person in the performance of his duties under this Act shall be guilty of an
offence.
(2) Any person who unlawfully damages, destroys or interferes with, or
attempts to damage, destroy or interfere with any bore, water storage tank, meter
or water works whatsoever shall be guilty of an offence.
(3) (a) Any person who causes or permits either directly or indirectly any
water to be polluted or causes or permits the doing of an act likely
to lead to the pollution of any water shall be guilty of an offence.
(b) Any person or public authority holding a licence under section 18
may discharge wastes under that licence.
(4) Any person who does not meet the requirements for water catchment,
graves, rubbish dumps, disposal of waste waters, swimming pool filling and
emptying, as stated in Water Resources Regulations, whatsoever shall be guilty of
an offence.
(5) Water is hereby declared to be a product capable of being stolen within
the meaning of section 188 of the Niue Act 1966 and any person who maliciously
or fraudulently abstracts, causes to be wasted or diverted, consumes, or uses any
such water shall be guilty of theft.

30 Penalties

(1) Subject to subsection (2) any person who contravenes or fails to comply
with this Act or of any Regulation made under it, or relating to the subject matter
of this Act shall be guilty of an offence and shall, where no specific penalty is
provided, on conviction be liable to a fine not exceeding 10 penalty units or to a
term of imprisonment; not exceeding 6 months or both such fine and imprisonment
and, in the case of a continuing offence, to an additional fine not exceeding 5
penalty units for every day or part of a day that the offence shall continue.
(2) Where no specific penalty is provided for any offence concerning the
pollution or any water or acts which may directly or indirectly cause pollution of
any water the maximum penalty shall be a fine not exceeding 500 penalty units or
a term of imprisonment of 2 years or both such fine and imprisonment, and in the
case of a continuing offence, an additional fine not exceeding 50 penalty units for
every day or part of a day that the offence shall continue.

Water Resources Act 1996

1765

31 Compensation

Whenever, for the purposes of Part 6, it becomes necessary to acquire or to
resume any land or interest under sections 11 or 14 of the Niue Amendment Act
(No 2) 1968, compensation under section 13 shall only be payable –
(a) In respect of land, that the storage tank, bore or equipment is erected
upon and the land surrounding such tank, bore and equipment as
long as the bore, storage tank and equipment is in use or likely to
be used;
(b) In respect of any damage occasioned and not made good in the
course of constructing, altering, repairing or maintaining any public
water works associated therewith; and not otherwise.

32 [Repealed]

1766 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1767

WILDLIFE ACT 1972

1972/74 – 9 March 1972

1

Short title

5

Powers of wildlife wardens

2

Interpretation

6

Forfeiture of property

3

Powers of Cabinet

7

Prohibition orders

4

Protection of animals

8

[Spent]

To make provision for the protection in Niue of wild animals and wild birds

1 Short title

This is the Wildlife Act 1972.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“absolutely protected animal” means any animal of a species which is under
section 3 declared to be an absolutely protected species;
“animal” means any mammal which is a wild species or any bird which is
of a wild species, but does not include any mammal of a domesticated
species or any bird of a domesticated species although it may be existing
in a wild state;
“bag limit” means the maximum number of partly protected animals of
any one particular species which, during any one day outside any
protection period relating to that species, any one person may kill or
trap;
“carcass” means the whole or any part of the dead body of any animal;
“partly protected animal” means any animal of a species which is under
section 3 declared to be a partly protected species;
“protected animal” means
(i) any absolutely protected animal; or
(ii) during any protection period relating to it, any partly protected
animal;
“protection period” means any period of time in any year during which
under any notice issued under section 3, any partly protected animal is
a protected animal;
“vehicle” means any motor vehicle, any bicycle, any boat or any canoe,
and includes any wheeled trailer towed or capable of being towed
behind any motor vehicle;
“wildlife warden” means any constable.
1768 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

3 Powers of Cabinet

(1) (a) Cabinet may, by notice in the Gazette declare, for the purposes of
this Act, any species of animal to be an absolutely protected species
or a partly protected species.
(b) Any such notice may state that it is to have effect with reference
only to some part or parts of Niue specified in the notice.
(2) Cabinet shall, in any notice issued under subsection (1) declaring any
species of animal to be a partly protected species, specify the period or periods of
time in the year in which such species is a protected animal and shall, if it thinks
fit, also specify in such notice a bag limit relating to that species.
(3) Cabinet may, by notice in the Gazette, revoke, vary or amend any notice
issued under subsection (1) or (2).

4 Protection of animals

(1) No person shall, without the prior written permission of Cabinet –
(i) Kill, injure or trap, or attempt to kill, injure or trap any protected
animal; or
(ii) Destroy, damage or take, or attempt to destroy, damage or take
the egg of any bird which is a protected animal; or
(iii) Disturb or attempt to disturb the nest or nesting place of any
bird which is a protected animal; or
(iv) Disturb or attempt to disturb the lair or roosting place of any
protected animal.
(2) Any permission referred to in subsection (1) may be given either
unconditionally or subject to any conditions which, in his absolute discretion,
Cabinet may in writing deem fit to impose, and any such permission may be
revoked by Cabinet.
(3)(a) Any person who acts contrary to subsection (1) or who acts in breach
of any conditions imposed under subsection (2) by Cabinet, commits
an offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding
forty dollars or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one week;
(b) No person shall be convicted of an offence under this subsection if
he proves to the satisfaction of the Court that the act constituting
the offence with which he is charged was, on his part, accidental
and unintended.
(4) Any person who in any one day kills or traps any number of partly
protected animals of a particular species in excess of the bag limit relating to such
species, commits an offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding
0.5 penalty units for each animal so killed or trapped by him in excess of such
limit, or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding one week.
(5) Any person who is, by a wildlife warden, found to have in his
possession, custody or control any animal or carcass shall be presumed, in the
absence of proof to the contrary, to have trapped or killed the animal concerned
during the period of one day immediately preceding the point of time at which he
is so found.

5 Powers of wildlife wardens

(1) Where any wildlife warden has reason to believe that any person has
committed an offence mentioned in section 4 he may, subject to subsection (2),
exercise all or any of the following powers –
(a) He may require that person immediately to give to him true and
full particulars of such person’s full names, occupation and place

Wildlife Act 1972 1769

of abode and, if such person fails to do so, or if the wildlife warden has reason to believe that all or any of such particulars are false, he may, without warrant, arrest such person;
(b) He may, without warrant, search any such person or any container or vehicle in the possession or control, or in the apparent possession or control, of such person;
(c) He may, without warrant, seize and take into his custody –
(i) Any animal or the carcass of any animal in the possession or
control, or in the apparent possession or control, of such person;
(ii) Any firearm, ammunition, trap, snare or other device in the
possession or control, or in the apparent possession or control,
of such person used or capable of being used for killing or
trapping any animal.
(2) A wildlife warden shall not, without the prior written permission of a
Judge of the Court or of a Commissioner, exercise in any private dwellinghouse
or in any private garden adjacent to any private dwellinghouse, any one or more
of the powers conferred upon a wildlife warden by subsection (1) (b) and (c).
(3) Any person who, when lawfully required so to do, fails immediately
to give to a wildlife warden all the particulars referred to in subsection (1) (a) or
who otherwise resists or obstructs a wildlife warden in the lawful exercise of any
one or more of the wildlife warden’s powers under that subsection commits an
offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units
or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 2 weeks.

6 Forfeiture of property

Where any person is convicted of an offence mentioned in section 4 (3) or
(4), the Court may order that any protected animal trapped by such person, or the
carcass of any protected animal killed by such person, or any egg taken by such
person in the course of committing the offence, or any firearm, trap, snare or other
device (other than a vehicle) owned by such person and used by such person for
the purposes of committing the offence, shall be absolutely forfeited to the Crown;
and, upon any such forfeiture, the animal carcass, egg or other thing so forfeited
shall become the absolute property of the Crown and shall be disposed of in such
manner as Cabinet may specify.

7 Prohibition orders

(1) Where any person is convicted of an offence contrary to this Act, the
Court may make an order prohibiting such person from killing, attempting to kill,
trapping and attempting to trap any protected animal for any period not exceeding
2 years from and including the date of the conviction.
(2) The Court may cancel any such order or reduce the period mentioned
in the order.
(3) Any person, in respect of whom any such order has been made and
who, during the subsistence of the order, acts contrary to the order, commits an
offence and, on conviction, shall be liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit or
to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 weeks.

8 [Spent]

1770 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1771

WILLS ACT 1837

1 Vict Cap XXVI – 3 July 1837

1

Meaning

20

Revocation of will

2

[Spent]

21

Alteration in a will

3

All property may be disposed of by will

22

Revival of will

4

Devisees of customary and copyhold

23

A devise not to be rendered inoperative by

estates

any subsequent conveyance or act

5

Wills of customary freeholds

24

A will to speak from the death of the

6

Estates pur autre vie

testator

7

Will of a person under age

25

A residuary devise

8

Will of a married woman

26

A general devise

9

Every will shall be in writing and signed

27

A general gift

by the testator in the presence of two

28

A devise without any words of limitation

witnesses at one time

29

The words “die without issue,” or “die

10

Appointments by will

without leaving issue” shall be construed

11

Soldiers and mariners wills

to mean die without issue living at the

12

Wills of seamen

death

13

Publication not to be requisite

30

No devise to trustees or executors, except

14

Incompetency of attesting witness

for a term or a presentation to a church,

15

Gifts to an attesting witness

shall pass a chattel interest

16

Creditor attesting to be admitted a witness

31

Trustees under an unlimited devise

17

Executor to be admitted a witness

32

Devises of estates tail

18

Will revoked by marriage

33

Gifts to children

19

No will revoked by presumption

34-36 –

By this Act, it is enacted,

1 That the words and expressions hereinafter mentioned, which in their

ordinary signification have a more confined or a different meaning, shall in this
Act, except where the nature of the provision or the context of the Act shall exclude
such construction, be interpreted as follows; (that is to say,) the word “Will” shall
extend to a testament, and to a codicil, and to an appointment by will or by writing
in the nature of a will in exercise of a power, and also to a disposition by will and
testament or devise of the custody and tuition of any child, by virtue of an Act, 12
Car. 2. c. 24, intituled, ‘An Act for taking away the Court of Wards and Liveries,
and Tenures in capite and by Knights Service, and Purveyance, and for settling a
Revenue upon His Majesty in lieu thereof,’ or by virtue of an Act, 14 & 15 Car. 2
(I.), intituled, ‘An Act for taking away the Court of Wards and Liveries, and Tenures
in capite and by Knights Service,’ and to any other testamentary disposition; and
the words “Real Estate” shall extend to manors, advowsons, messuages, lands,
tithes, rents and hereditaments, whether freehold, customary freehold, tenant right,
customary or copyhold, or of any other tenure, and whether corporeal, incorporeal,
or personal, and to any undivided share thereof, and to any estate, right, or interest
(other than a chattel interest) therein; and the words “Personal Estates” shall extend
to leasehold estates and other chattels real, and also to monies, shares of
1772 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
government and other funds, securities for money (not being real estates), debts, choses in action, rights, credits, goods, and all other property whatsoever which by law devolves upon the executor or administrator, and to any share or interest therein; and every word importing the single number only shall extend and be applied to several persons or things as well as one person or thing; and every word importing the masculine gender only shall extend and be applied to a female as well as a male.

2 [Spent]

3 That it shall be lawful for every person to devise, bequeath, or dispose of, by his will executed in manner hereinafter required, all real estate and all personal estate which he shall be entitled to, either at law or in equity, at the time of his death, and which if not so devised, bequeathed, or disposed of would devolve upon the heir at law, or customary heir of him or, if he became entitled by descent, of his ancestor, or upon his executor or administrator; and that the power hereby given shall extend to all real estate of the nature of customary freehold or tenant right, or customary or copyhold, notwithstanding that the testator may not have surrendered the same to the use of his will, or notwithstanding that, being entitled as heir, devisee, or otherwise to be admitted thereto, he shall not have been admitted thereto, or notwithstanding that the same, in consequence of the want of a custom to devise or surrender to the use of a will or otherwise, could not at law have been disposed of by will if this Act had not been made, or notwithstanding that the same, in consequence of there being a custom that a will or a surrender to the use of a will should continue in force for a limited time only, or any other special custom, could not have been disposed of by will according to the power contained in this Act, if this Act had not been made; and also to estates pur autre vie, whether there shall or shall not be any special occupant thereof, and whether the same shall be freehold, customary freehold, tenant right, customary or copyhold, or of any other tenure, and whether the same shall be a corporeal or an incorporeal hereditament; and also to all contingent, executory, or other future interests in any real or personal estate, whether the testator may or may not be ascertained as the person or one of the persons in whom the same respectively may become vested, and whether he may be entitled thereto under the instrument by which the same respectively were created or under any disposition thereof by deed or will; and also to all rights of entry for conditions broken and other rights of entry; and also to such of the same estates, interests, and rights respectively, and other real and personal estate, as the testator may be entitled to at the time of his death, notwithstanding that he may become entitled to the same subsequently to the execution of his will.

4 Provided always, That where any real estate of the nature of customary freehold or tenant right, or customary or copyhold, might, by the custom of the manor of which the same is holden, have been surrendered to the use of a will, and the testator shall not have surrendered the same to the use of his will, no person entitled or claiming to be entitled thereto by virtue of such will shall be entitled to be admitted, except upon payment of all such stamp duties, fees, and sums of money as would have been lawfully due and payable in respect of the surrendering of such real estate to the use of the will, or in respect of presenting, registering, or enrolling such surrender, if the same real estate had been surrendered to the use of the will of such testator: Provided also that where the testator was entitled to have been admitted to such real estate, and might, if he had been

Wills Act 1837 1773

admitted *hereto, have surrendered the same to the use of his will, and shall not have been admitted thereto, no person entitled to claiming to be entitled to such real estate in consequence of such will shall be entitled to be admitted to the same real estate by virtue thereof, except on payment of all such stamp duties, fees, fine, and sums of money as would have been lawfully due and payable in respect of the admittance of such testator to such real estate, and also of all such stamp duties, fees, and sums of money as would have been lawfully due and payable in respect of surrendering such real estate to the use of the will, or of presenting, registering, or enrolling such surrender, had the testator been duly admitted to such real estate, and afterwards surrendered the same to the use of his will; all which stamp duties, fees, fine, or sums of money due as aforesaid shall be paid in addition to the stamp duties, fees, fine, or sums of money due or payable on the admittance of such person, so entitled or claiming to be entitled to the same real estate as aforesaid.

5 That when any real estate of the nature of customary freehold or tenant right, or customary or copyhold, shall be disposed of by the will, the lord of the manor or reputed manor of which such real estate is holden, or his steward, or the deputy of such steward, shall cause the will by which such disposition shall be made, or so much thereof as shall contain the disposition of such real estate, to be entered on the court rolls of such manor or reputed manor; and when any trusts are declared by the will of such real estate, it shall not be necessary to enter the declaration of such trusts; but it shall be sufficient to state in the entry on the court rolls that such real estate is subject to the trusts declared by such will; and when any such real estate could not have been disposed of by will if this Act had not been made, the same fine, heriot, dues, duties, and services shall be paid and rendered by the devisee as would have been due from the customary heir in case of the descent of the same real estate, and the lord shall as against the devisee of such estate have the same remedy for recovering and enforcing such fine, heriot dues, duties, and services as he is now entitled to for recovering and enforcing the same from or against the customary heir in case of a descent.

6 That if no disposition by will shall be made of any estate pur autre vie of a freehold nature, the same shall be chargeable in the hands of the heir, if it shall come to him by reason of special occupancy, as assets by descent, as in the case of freehold land in fee simple; and in case there shall be no special occupant of any estate pur autre vie, whether freehold or customary freehold, tenant right, customary or copyhold, or of any other tenure, and whether a corporeal or incorporeal hereditament, it shall go to the executor or administrator of the party that had the estate thereof by virtue of the grant; and if the same shall come to the executor or administrator either by reason of a special occupancy or by virtue of this Act, it shall be assets in his hands, and shall go and be applied and distributed in the same manner as the personal estate of the testator or intestate.

7 That no will made by any person under twenty-one years shall be valid.

8 Provided also, That no will made by any married woman shall be valid, except such a will as might have been made by a married woman before the passing of this Act.

1774 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

9 That no will shall be valid unless it shall be in writing and executed in manner hereinafter mentioned; (that is to say,) it shall be signed at the foot or end thereof by the testator, or by some other person in his presence and by his direction; and such signature shall be made or acknowledged by the testator in the presence of two or more witnesses present at the same time, and such witnesses shall attest and shall subscribe the will in the presence of the testator, but no form of attestation shall be necessary.

10 That no appointment made by will, in exercise of any power, shall be valid, unless the same be executed in manner hereinbefore required; and every will executed in manner hereinbefore required shall, so far as respects the execution and attestation thereof, be a valid execution of a power of appointment by will, notwithstanding it shall have been expressly required that a will made in exercise of such power should be executed with some additional or other form of execution or solemnity.

11 Provided always, That any soldier being in actual military service, or any mariner or seamen being at sea, may dispose of his personal estate as he might have done before the making of this Act.

12 That this Act shall not prejudice or affect any of the provisions contained in an Act intituled, ‘An Act to amend and consolidate the Laws relating to the Pay of the Royal Navy,’ respecting the wills of petty officers and seamen in the Royal Navy, and non-commissioned officers of marines, and marines, so far as relates to their wages, pay, prize money, bounty money, and allowances, or other monies payable in respect of services in Her Majesty’s Navy.

13 That every will executed in manner hereinbefore required shall be valid without any other publication thereof.

14 That if any person who shall attest the execution of a will shall at the time of the execution thereof, or at any time afterwards, be incompetent to be admitted a witness to prove the execution thereof, such will shall not on that account be invalid.

15 That if any person who shall attest the execution of any will to whom or to whose wife or husband any beneficial devise, legacy, estate, interest, gift or appointment, of or affecting any real or personal estate (other than and except charges and directions for the payment of any debt or debts), shall be thereby given or made, such devise, legacy, estate, interest, gift, or appointment shall, so far only as concerns such person attesting the execution of such will, or the wife or husband of such person, or any person claiming under such person or wife or husband, be utterly null and void, and such person so attesting shall be admitted as a witness to prove the execution of such will, or to prove the validity or invalidity thereof, notwithstanding such devise, legacy, estate, interest, gift, or appointment mentioned in such will.

16 That in case by any will any real or personal estate shall be charged with any debt or debts, and any creditor, or the wife or husband of any creditor, whose debt is so charged, shall attest the execution of such will, such creditor notwithstanding such charge shall be admitted a witness to prove the execution of such will, or to prove the validity or invalidity thereof.

Wills Act 1837 1775

17 That no person shall, on account of his being an executor of a will, be incompetent to be admitted a witness to prove the execution of such will, or a witness to prove the validity or invalidity thereof.

18 That every will made by a man or woman shall be revoked by his or her marriage (except a will made in exercise of a power of appointment, when the real or personal estate thereby appointed would not in default of such appointment pass to his or her heir, customary heir, executor, or administrator, or the person entitled as his or her next of kin, under the Statute of Distributions).

19 That no will shall be revoked by any presumption of an intention on the ground of an alteration in circumstances.

20 That no will or codicil, or any part thereof, shall be revoked otherwise than as aforesaid, or by another will or codicil executed in manner hereinbefore required, or by some writing declaring an intention to revoke the same, and executed in the manner in which a will is hereinbefore required to be executed, or by the burning, tearing, or otherwise destroying the same by the testator, or by some person in his presence and by his direction, with the intention of revoking the same.

21 That no obliteration, interlineation or other alteration made in any will after the execution thereof shall be valid or have any effect, except so far as the words or effect of the will before such alteration shall not be apparent, unless such alteration shall be executed in like manner as is hereinbefore required for the execution of the will; but the will, with such alteration as part thereof, shall be deemed to be duly executed if the signature of the testator and the subscription of the witnesses be made in the margin or on some other part of the will opposite or near to such alteration, or at the foot or end of or opposite to a memorandum referring to such alteration, and written at the end or some other part of the will.

22 That no will or codicil, or any part thereof, which shall be in any manner revoked, shall be revived otherwise than by the re-execution thereof, or by a codicil executed in manner hereinbefore required, and shewing an intention to revive the same; and when any will or codicil which shall be partly revoked, and afterwards wholly revoked, shall be revived, such revival shall not extend to so much thereof as shall have been revoked before the revocation of the whole thereof, unless an intention to the contrary shall be shewn.

23 That no conveyance or other act made or done subsequently to the execution of a will of or relating to any real or personal estate therein comprised, except an act by which such will shall be revoked as aforesaid, shall prevent the operation of the will with respect to such estate or interest in such real or personal estate as the testator shall have power to dispose of by will at the time of his death.

24 That every will shall be construed, with reference to the real estate and personal estate comprised in it, to speak and take effect as if it had been executed immediately before the death of the testator, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will.

1776 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

25 That, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will, such real estate or interest therein as shall be comprised or intended to be comprised in any devise in such will contained, which shall fail or be void by reason of the death of the devisee in the lifetime of the testator, or by reason of such devise being contrary to law or otherwise incapable of taking effect, shall be included in the residuary devise (if any) contained in such will.

26 That a devise of the land of the testator, or of the land of the testator in any place or in the occupation of any person mentioned in his will, or otherwise described in a general manner, and any other general devise which would describe a customary, copyhold, or leasehold estate if the testator had no freehold estate which could be described by it, shall be construed to include the customary, copyhold, and leasehold estates of the testator, or his customary, copyhold and leasehold estates, or any of them, to which such description shall extend, as the case may be, as well as freehold estates, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will.

27 That a general devise of the real estate of the testator, or of the real estate of the testator in any place or in the occupation of any person mentioned in his will, or otherwise described in a general manner, shall be construed to include any real estate, or any real estate to which such description shall extend (as the case may be), which he may have power to appoint in any manner he may think proper, and shall operate as an execution of such power, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will; and in like manner a bequest of the personal estate of the testator, or any bequest of personal property described in a general manner, shall be construed to include any personal estate, or any personal estate to which such description shall extend (as the case may be), which he may have power to appoint in any manner he may think proper, and shall operate as an execution of such power, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will.

28 That where any real estate shall be devised to any person without any words of limitation, such devise shall be construed to pass the fee simple, or other the whole estate or interest which the testator had power to dispose of by will in such real estate, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will.

29 That in any devise or bequest of real or personal estate the words “die without issue,” or “die without leaving issue,” or “have no issue,” or any other words which may import either a want or failure of issue of any person in his lifetime or at the time of his death, or an indefinite failure of his issue, shall be construed to mean a want or failure of issue in the lifetime or at the time of the death of such person, and not an indefinite failure of his issue, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will, by reason of such person having a prior estate tail, or of a preceding gift, being, without any implication arising from such words, a limitation of an estate tail to such person or issue, or otherwise: Provided, that this Act shall not extend to cases where such words as aforesaid import if no issue described in a preceding gift shall be born, or if there shall be no issue who shall live to attain the age or otherwise answer the description required for obtaining a vested estate by a preceding gift to such issue.

Wills Act 1837 1777

30 That where any real estate (other than or not being a presentation to a church) shall be devised to any trustee or executor, such devise shall be construed to pass the fee simple or other the whole estate or interest which the testator had power to dispose of by will in such real estate, unless a definite term of years, absolute or determinable, or an estate of freehold, shall thereby be given to him expressly or by implication.

31 That where any real estate shall be devised to a trustee, without any express limitation of the estate to be taken by such trustee, and the beneficial interest in such real estate, or in the surplus rents and profits thereof, shall not be given to any person for life, or such beneficial interest shall be given to any person for life, but the purposes of the trust may continue beyond the life of such person, such devise shall be construed to vest in such trustee the fee simple, or other the whole legal estate which the testator had power to dispose of by will in such real estate, and not an estate determinable when the purposes of the trust shall be satisfied.

32 That where any person to whom any real estate shall be devised for an estate tail or an estate in quasi entail shall die in the lifetime of the testator leaving issue who would be inheritable under such entail, and any such issue shall be living at the time of the death of the testator, such devise shall not lapse, but shall take effect as if the death of such person had happened immediately after the death of the testator, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will.

33 That where any person being a child or other issue of the testator to whom any real or personal estate shall be devised or bequeathed for any estate or interest not determinable at or before the death of such person shall die in the lifetime of the testator leaving issue, and any such issue of such person shall be living at the time of death of the testator, such devise or bequest shall not lapse, but shall take effect as if the death of such person had happened immediately after the death of the testator, unless a contrary intention shall appear by the will.

34-36

1778 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1779

WILLS ACT AMENDMENT ACT 1852

15 and 16 Vict ch 24 (UK) – 17 June 1852

For the amendment of the Wills Act 1837

1 Position of testator’s signature

Where by the Wills Act 1837 it is enacted , that no will shall be valid unless
it shall be signed at the foot or end of it by the testator, or by some other person in
his presence, and by his direction: Every will shall, so far only as regards the
position of the signature of the testator, or of the person signing for him as aforesaid,
be deemed to be valid within the said enactment, as explained by this Act, if the
signature shall be so placed at or after, or following, or under, or beside, or opposite
to the end of the will, that it shall be apparent on the face of the will that the
testator intended to give effect by such his signature to the writing signed as his
will; and no such will shall be affected by the circumstance that the signature shall
not follow or be immediately after the foot or end of the will, or by the circumstance
that a blank space shall intervene between the concluding word of the will and
the signature, or by the circumstance that the signature shall be placed among the
words of the testimonium clause or of the clause of attestation, or shall follow or
be after or under the clause of attestation, either with or without a blank space
intervening, or shall follow or be after, or under, or beside the names or one of the
names of the subscribing witnesses, or by the circumstance that the signature shall
be on a side or page or other portion of the paper or papers containing the will
whereon no clause or paragraph or disposing part of the will shall be written
above the signature, or by the circumstance that there shall appear to be sufficient
space on or at the bottom of the preceding side or page or other portion of the
same paper on which the will is written to contain the signature; and the
enumeration of the above circumstances shall not restrict the generality of the
above enactment; but no signature under the said Act or this Act shall be operative
to give effect to any disposition or direction which is underneath or which follows
it nor shall it give effect to any disposition or direction inserted after the signature
shall be made.

2 [Spent]

3-4 –

1780 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

1781

WRECK AND SALVAGE ACT 1968

1968/53 – 4 November 1968

1

Short title

13

Wreck claimed by two or more persons, or

2

Interpretation

unclaimed

3

Superintendence and receiver of wreck

14

Removal of wrecked ships and aircraft

4

Duties of receiver when ship or aircraft in

15

Offences in respect of wreck

distress

16

Receiver may seize concealed wreck

5

Powers of receiver in preserving ship or

17

Salvage

aircraft

18

Determination of salvage disputes

6

Right of passage over adjoining lands

19

Enforcing payment of salvage

7

Receiver to suppress plunder and disorder

20

Receiver may sell wreck in case of non­

8

Receiver to make inquiry

payment

9

Dealing with wreck

21

Foreign wreck subject to duties as an

10

Articles washed ashore

importation

11

Claim to wreck

22

Offences

12

Wreck may be sold immediately in certain

23

Limitation of time in proceedings

cases

To provide for wrecks and salvage and for matters incidental and related

1 Short title

This is the Wreck and Salvage Act 1968.

2 Interpretation

In this Act –
“boat” means any small craft, whether open or deck, and includes barges,
lighters and like vessels;
“master” means any person (except a pilot) having command or charge of
any ship;
“receiver” means the receiver of wreck for Niue as specified in section 3 (1)
and includes any person appointed by him under section 3 (2);
“salvage” includes all expenses properly incurred by the salvor in the
performance of the salvage services;
“ship” means any vessel customarily used for the carriage of passengers
or goods but does not include barges, lighters and like vessels;
“wreck” includes any property which a receiver is required or authorised
by this Act to take into his possession and includes jetsam, flotsam,
ligan and derelict found in or on the shores of the sea.
1782 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

3 Superintendence and receiver of wreck

(1) The Financial Secretary shall be the receiver of wreck for Niue and shall
have the general superintendence throughout Niue of all matters relating to wreck
and salvage.
(2) The Financial Secretary may appoint any person to act for him and to
perform all such duties of the receiver as are mentioned in this Act, and that person
may exercise those powers in the same manner and with the same effect as if they
had been conferred upon him directly by this section; and any person preparing
to act with the authority of the receiver under this section shall be presumed to be
acting in accordance with authority in the absence of proof to the contrary.

4 Duties of receiver when ship or aircraft in distress

(1) Where a ship or aircraft is wrecked, stranded or in distress at any place
on or over or near the coast of Niue, the receiver shall upon being informed of the
circumstance, forthwith proceed there and, upon his arrival shall take the command
of all persons present and shall assign such duties and give such directions to
each person as he thinks fit for the preservation of the ship or aircraft and the lives
of the persons (shipwrecked persons) and of the cargo and equipment of the ship
or aircraft.
(2) The receiver shall not interfere between the master and the crew of the
ship, or, as the case may be between the person in command and the crew of the
aircraft; nor shall the receiver take into his possession any ship or aircraft or any
cargo or equipment belonging to it, while that ship or aircraft remains in the
possession of the master or person in command of it, unless he is requested to do
so by that master or person in command.

5 Powers of receiver in preserving ship or aircraft

(1) The receiver may, with a view to preservation of the ship or aircraft or
of the lives of the shipwrecked persons or of its cargo or equipments –
(a) Require such persons as he thinks necessary to assist him;
(b) Require the master or other person having the charge of any ship
or other vessel or boat near at hand to give such aid with his men
or ship or other vessel or boat as may be in his power; and
(c) Demand the use of any vehicle or horses that may be at hand.
(2) Every person commits an offence against this Act who –
(a) Wilfully disobeys the lawful direction of the receiver; or
(b) Refuses without reasonable cause to comply with any lawful
requisition or demand made by the receiver under this section.

6 Right of passage over adjoining lands

(1) Where a ship or aircraft is wrecked, stranded, or in distress as aforesaid,
all persons may, for the purpose of rendering assistance to the ship or aircraft, or
of saving the lives of the shipwrecked persons, or of saving the cargo or equipments
of the ship or aircraft, unless there is some public road equally convenient, pass
and repass, either with or without vehicles or horses, over any adjoining lands
without being subject to interruption by the owner or occupier, so that they do as
little damage as possible, and may also on the like condition, deposit on those
land any cargo or other article recovered from the ship or aircraft.
(2) Any damage sustained by an owner or occupier in consequence of the
exercise of the rights given by this section shall be a charge on the ship or aircraft
or cargo or articles in respect of or by which the damage is occasioned; and the
amount payable in respect of the damage shall in case of dispute be determined,
and shall in default of payment be recoverable, in the same manner as the amount
of salvage is under this Act determined or recoverable.

Wreck and Salvage Act 1968

1783
who –
(3) Every owner or occupier of land commits an offence against this Act
(a) Impedes or hinders any person in the exercise of the rights given by this section, by locking his gates, or refusing upon request to open the same, or otherwise; or
(b) Impedes or hinders the deposit on the land of any cargo or other article recovered from the ship or aircraft as aforesaid; or
(c) Prevents or endeavours to prevent any such cargo or other article from remaining deposited on the land for a reasonable time until it can be removed to a safe place of public deposit.

7 Receiver to suppress plunder and disorder

Where a ship or aircraft is wrecked, stranded, or in distress as aforesaid,
and any person plunders, creates disorder, or obstructs the preservation of the
ship or aircraft or of the shipwrecked persons or of the cargo or equipments of the
ship or aircraft, the receiver may cause that person to be apprehended.

8 Receiver to make inquiry

(1) Where any ship or aircraft is or has been in distress on or over or near
the coasts of Niue, the receiver shall, as soon as conveniently may be, examine on
oath or affirmation any person belonging to the ship or aircraft, or any other person
who may be able to give an account of it or of its cargo or stores as to the following
matters –
(a) The name and description of the ship or aircraft;
(b) The names of the owners and the master of the ship, or, as the case
may be, the names of the owners and the person in command of
the aircraft;
(c) The names of the owners of the cargo;
(d) The ports from and to which the ship or aircraft was bound;
(e) In the case of a ship, the occasion of its distress;
(f) The services rendered; and
(g) Such other matters or circumstances relating to the ship or aircraft,
or to the cargo or store of it as the receiver holding the examination
thinks necessary.
(2) The receiver holding the examination shall take the same down in
writing, and shall send it to the Cabinet who shall take such action to advise the
owners of the ship or aircraft or of the cargo and such other persons as he thinks
fit.

9 Dealing with wreck

(1) Where any person finds or takes possession of any wreck within Niue
or takes possession of and brings within the limits of Niue and wreck found outside
those limits, he shall –
(a) If he is the owner, give notice to the receiver, stating that he has
found or taken possession of the wreck, and describing the marks
by which the same may be recognised;
(b) If he is not the owner, as soon as possible deliver the same to the
receiver.
(2) Any person who fails without reasonable cause to comply with this
section commits an offence against this Act and shall in addition, if he is not the
owner, forfeit any claim to salvage, and shall be liable to pay to the owner of the
wreck if it is claimed, or, if it is unclaimed, to the person entitled to the same,
double the value of it, to be recovered in the same way as a fine of a like amount
under this Act.
1784 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3

10 Articles washed ashore

(1) Where a ship or aircraft is wrecked, stranded, or in distress at any place
on or over or near the coasts of Niue, any cargo or equipments or other articles
belonging to or separated from the ship or aircraft which may be washed on shore,
or otherwise lost or taken from the ship or aircraft, shall be delivered to the receiver.
(2) Every person, whether the owner or not, who secrets or keeps
possession of any such cargo or equipments or article, or refuses to deliver the
same to the receiver or any person authorised by him to demand the same, commits
an offence against this Act.
(3) The receiver or any person authorised as aforesaid may take any such
cargo or equipment or article by force from the person so refusing to deliver the
same.

11 Claim to wreck

(1) Where the receiver takes possession of any wreck, he shall within 48
hours make the same known by public notice given in his name and such notice
shall include a description of the wreck and of any marks by which it is
distinguished.
(2) The owner of any wreck in the possession of the receiver, upon
establishing his claim to the same, to the satisfaction of the receiver within one
year from the time at which the wreck came into the possession of the receiver
shall, upon paying the salvage, fees, and expenses due, be entitled to have the
wreck or the proceeds delivered to him.
(3) Where any ship or aircraft is wrecked, stranded or abandoned on or
near the coasts of Niue and there is no owner or agent of the owner or other
person present in Niue authorised to protect the interests of the owners, the receiver
shall make known to the owners in New Zealand, if the ship or aircraft is registered
there, or to a trade or other representative in New Zealand of the Commonwealth
country, or, as the case may be a consular representative in New Zealand of a
foreign country, in which that ship or aircraft may have been registered or to which
that ship or aircraft may have belonged, the facts of the wreck, stranding or
abandonment, and shall act under instructions received from the owners or trade
or other representative or consular representative as the case may be, or from any
agent, duly appointed as far as related to the custody and disposal of that ship or
aircraft.
(4) Where any wreck, whether or not belonging to or separated from any
ship or aircraft to which subsection (3) applies, is found within the limits of Niue
or is brought within those limits, and it does not appear that the wreck belongs to
persons resident in Niue or in New Zealand, a trade or other representative in
New Zealand of the Commonwealth country, or as the case may be, a consular
representative of the foreign country, to which the owners of the wreck may belong
shall, be deemed in the absence of the owners and of any other agent of the owners,
to be the agent of the owners, as far as relates to the custody and disposal of the
wreck.

12 Wreck may be sold immediately in certain cases

(1) The receiver may at any time sell any wreck in his custody, if in his
opinion –
(a) It is under the value of $10; or
(b) It is so much damaged or of so perishable a nature that it cannot
with advantage be kept; or
(c) It is not of sufficient value to pay for warehousing.

Wreck and Salvage Act 1968

1785
(2) The proceeds of the sale shall, after defraying the expenses, be held by the receiver for the same purposes and subject to the same claims, rights and liabilities as if the wreck had remained unsold.

13 Wreck claimed by two or more persons, or unclaimed

(1) Where a dispute arises between 2 or more persons as to the title to the
wreck, the dispute may be determined in the same manner as if it were a dispute
as to salvage to be determined under this Act.
(2) Upon delivery of wreck or the payment of the proceeds of sale of wreck
by the receiver, he shall be discharged from all liability in respect of it; but the
delivery of it shall not prejudice or affect any question which may be raised by
third parties concerning the right or title to the wreck.
(3) Where no owner establishes a claim to any wreck found within the
limits of Niue, and in the possession of the receiver, within one year after it came
into his possession, it shall be the property of Her Majesty, and the receiver shall
sell the same and shall pay the proceeds of sale (after deducting from it the expenses
of sale and any other expenses incurred by him, and his fees, and paying thereout
to the salvors such amount of salvage as Cabinet may in each case, or by any
general rule, determine) into the Niue Government Account.

14 Removal of wrecked ships and aircraft

(1) If any ship or aircraft is sunk stranded or abandoned on or near the
coasts of Niue, and there is no authority in any other Act or rule or regulation to
remove or destroy that ship or aircraft, Cabinet may, and shall, if in his opinion
the ship or aircraft is, or is likely to become an obstruction to navigation (or danger
to property, life or limb) direct the receiver to cause that ship or aircraft to be
removed.
(2) On receiving such a direction, the receiver, by notice in writing given
to the owner or master of the ship or any agent of the owner or, as the case may be,
to the owner or person in command of the aircraft or to any agent of the owner,
shall require the owner to remove that ship or aircraft, or any part of it, in a manner
satisfactory to, and within a time to be notified by, the receiver.
(3) If the owner fails to comply with the notice, or if neither the owner nor
the master of the ship, or as the case may be, neither the owner nor the person in
command of the aircraft, nor in either case may agent of the owner can be found,
the receiver may –
(a) Take possession of and remove or destroy the whole or any part of
the ship or aircraft; and
(b) Sell, in such manner as he thinks fit, the ship or aircraft, or any part
of it, so removed, and also any property recovered from it in the
exercise of his powers under this section; and, out of the proceeds
of any such sale, without any reference to the articles from the same
of which those proceeds arise, reimburse the Crown for the whole
of the expenses of removal; and
(c) If the proceeds of the sale are insufficient to pay the whole of the
expenses of removal, recover the balance from the owner of the
ship or aircraft or from the owner of any other ship or aircraft or
from any other person if the sinking, stranding or abandonment
occurred through the fault or negligence of that other ship, aircraft
or person.
(4) Subject to subsection (5), the receiver shall hold and dispose of the
surplus (if any) of the proceeds of any sale under this section in accordance with
the provisions of this Act relating to wreck.
1786 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(5) This subsection shall apply to every article belonging to or forming part of a ship or aircraft, as it applies to a ship or aircraft; and the proceeds of the sale under this section of any ship or aircraft or part of it or other property recovered shall be regarded as a common fund.
(6) In this section “owner”, in relation to any ship or aircraft which has been sunk, stranded, or abandoned, includes not only the owners of the ship or aircraft at the time of its sinking, standing or abandonment, but also any subsequent purchaser of the ship or aircraft or of any article belonging to it or forming part of it as long as the ship or aircraft remains sunk, stranded or abandoned.

15 Offences in respect of wreck

(1) Any person who takes into any port out of Niue any ship or aircraft,
stranded, derelict, or otherwise in distress, found on or near the coasts of Niue, or
any part of the cargo or equipment of it, or anything belonging to it, or any wreck
found within those limits, and there sells the same, commits an offence against
this Act and shall be liable on conviction or indictment to imprisonment for a
term not exceeding 5 years or to a fine not exceeding 20 penalty units.
(2) Every person, not being a receiver or a person lawfully acting as such
or a person acting by the command of any such person as aforesaid, commits an
offence against this Act who boards or endeavours to board any ship or aircraft
which is wrecked, stranded, or otherwise in distress on or near the coasts of Niue
unless he acts with the leave of the master of the ship or, as the case may be, the
person in command of the aircraft, and every such master or person in command
may repel him by force.
(3) Every person commits an offence against this Act who –
(a) Impedes or hinders, or endeavours in any way to impede or hinder,
the saving of any ship or aircraft stranded or in danger of being
stranded or otherwise in distress on or over or near the coasts of
Niue, or of any part of the cargo or equipment of any ship or aircraft
or of any wreck; or
(b) Secretes any wreck, or defaces or obliterates any marks on it;
(c) Wrongfully carries away or removes any part of a ship or aircraft
stranded or in danger of being stranded or otherwise in distress on
or near the coasts of Niue, or any part of the cargo or equipments of
any such ship or aircraft, or any wreck,
and every such person shall be liable for each offence to a fine not exceeding 1
penalty unit, and that penalty may be inflicted in addition to any other penalty to
which that person may be liable by law under this Act or otherwise.

16 Receiver may seize concealed wreck

(1) Where the receiver suspects or receives information that any wreck is
secreted or in the possession of some person who is not the owner of it, or that any
wreck is otherwise improperly dealt with, he may apply to any Judge of the Court
for a search warrant and such Judge shall have power to grant such a warrant,
and the receiver, by virtue of it, may enter any house or other place, wherever
situate, and also any ship, and search for, seize, and detain any such wreck found
there.
(2) If any such seizure of wreck is made in consequence of information given by any person to the receiver, on a warrant being issued under this section the informant shall be entitled by way of salvage to such sum, not exceeding in any case $10 as the Cabinet allows.

Wreck and Salvage Act 1968

1787

17 Salvage

(1) Where services are rendered –
(a) Wholly or in part within Niue waters in saving life from any ship
or aircraft; or
(b) Elsewhere in saving life from any Commonwealth ship or any
unregistered ship which is owned wholly by persons qualified to
own a registered New Zealand ship, or any aircraft which is
registered in or belongs to any Commonwealth country –
there shall be payable to the salvor by the owner of the ship or aircraft or cargo or
equipment saved a reasonable amount of salvage, to be determined in case of
dispute in manner hereinafter mentioned.
(2) Salvage in respect of the preservation of life, when payable by the
owners of the ship or aircraft, shall be payable in priority to all other claims for
salvage.
(3) Where the ship or aircraft and its cargo and equipment are destroyed,
or their value is insufficient, after payment of the actual expenses incurred, to pay
the amount of salvage payable in respect of the preservation of life, Cabinet may
award to the salvor, out of any money appropriated by the Assembly for the
purpose, such sum as he thinks fit in whole or part satisfaction of any amount of
salvage so left unpaid.
(4) Where –
(a) Any ship or aircraft is wrecked, stranded, or in distress on or over
or near the coasts of Niue, and services are rendered by any person
in assisting that ship or aircraft, or in saving the cargo or equipments
of it or any part of it, or
(b) Services are rendered by any person other than the receiver in saving
any wreck;
there shall be payable to the salvor by the owners of the ship or aircraft or cargo or
wreck a reasonable amount of salvage, to be determined in case of dispute in
manner hereinafter mentioned.

18 Determination of salvage disputes

(1) Disputes as to the amount of salvage, whether of life or property, arising
between the salvor and the owners of any ship or aircraft or cargo or equipments
or wreck shall, if not settled by agreement, arbitration or otherwise, be determined
by the Court.
(2) Disputes relating to salvage may be determined on the application either
of the salvor or of the owner of the property saved, or of their respective agents.
(3) The Court may, for the purpose of determining any dispute relating to
salvage, call to its assistance as assessor any person conversant with maritime or
aeronautical affairs; and there shall be paid, as part of the cost of the proceedings,
to every such assessor in respect of his services such sum as Cabinet directs.
(4) Any party aggrieved by the decision of the Court may, if the sum in
dispute exceeds $400, appeal to the Court of Appeal.

19 Enforcing payment of salvage

(1) Where salvage is due to any person under this Act the receiver shall –
(a) If the salvage is due in respect of services rendered in assisting any
ship or aircraft, or in saving life from it, or in saving the cargo and
equipments of it, detain the ship or aircraft and cargo or equipments;
and
1788 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 3
(b) If the salvage is due in respect of the saving of any wreck, and the wreck is not sold as unclaimed under this Act, detain the wreck.
(2) Subject as hereinafter mentioned, the receiver shall detain the ship or aircraft and the cargo and equipments, or the wreck (hereinafter referred to as detained property), until payment is made for salvage, or process is issued for its arrest or detention by a competent court.
(3) The receiver may release any detained property if security is given to his satisfaction or, if the claim for salvage exceeds $400 and any question is raised as to the sufficiency of the security, to the satisfaction of the Court.
(4) Any security given for salvage under this section to an amount exceeding $400 may be enforced by the Court in the same manner as if bail had been given in that Court.

20 Receiver may sell wreck in case of non-payment

(1) The receiver may sell any detained property if the persons liable to pay
salvage in respect of which the property is detained are aware of the detention, in
the following cases, namely –
(a) Where the amount is not disputed, and payment of the amount
due is not made within 90 days after the amount is due; or
(b) Where the amount is disputed, but no appeal lies from the first
Court to which the dispute is referred, and payment is not made
within 90 days after the decision of the first Court; or
(c) Where the amount is disputed, and an appeal lies from the decision
of the first Court to some other Court, and within 90 days of the
decision of the first Court neither payment of the sum due is made
nor evidence is produced that proceedings are to be commenced
for the purpose of appeal.
(2) The proceeds of sale of detained property shall, after payment of the
expenses of sale, be applied by the receiver in payment of the expenses, fees, and
salvage, and the surplus (if any) shall be paid to the owners of the property or any
other persons entitled to receive the same.

21 Foreign wreck subject to duties as an importation

(1) All wreck, being goods brought or coming into Niue from parts beyond
the seas shall be subject to the same duties as if the same was imported into Niue,
and if any question arises as to the origin of the goods they shall be deemed to be
the produce of such country as Cabinet may on investigation determine.
(2) Cabinet may permit all goods saved from any ship or aircraft stranded
or wrecked on her homeward voyage to be forwarded to the port of her original
destination, and all goods saved from any ship or aircraft stranded or wrecked on
her outward voyage to be returned to the port at which they were laden; but
Cabinet shall take security for the revenue in respect of those goods.
(3) In this section “goods’” includes any part of any ship or aircraft and
the cargo, machinery, and equipment and any other property belonging to it.

22 Offences

(1) Every person who commits an offence against this Act for which no
penalty is provided elsewhere than in this section shall be liable in respect of each
offence to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units.
(2) Where an offence against this Act is a continuing one, and no penalty is
provided for the continuance of it elsewhere than in this section, every person
who commits that offence shall, in addition to any other liability, be liable to a fine

Wreck and Salvage Act 1968

1789
not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day or part of a day during which the offence continues.

23 Limitation of time in proceedings

No conviction for an offence shall be made under this Act other than for an
offence under section 15, unless such proceeding is commenced within one year after the commission of the offence.

1790 Niue W:ws 2006 Vol 3

Niue Laws (Volume 4)

NIUE LAWS

TAU FAKATUFONO-TOHI A NIUE

LEGISLATION AS AT DECEMBER 2006

VOLUME 4 TOHI 4

SUBSIDIARY LEGISLATION

GOVERNMENT OF NIUE, ALOFI

2006

Copyright 2006 All rights reserved

Enquiries concerning the copyright material

should be addressed to the

Crown Law Office, Alofi, Niue

Printed by Stylex Print, Palmerston North, New Zealand

VOLUME FOUR

CONSTITUTION OF NIUE

Niue Assembly Standing Orders .......................................................................... 1
Public Service Regulations .................................................................................... 26

AGRICULTURE QUARANTINE ACT 1985

Animal Quarantine (Disease Control) Regulations ........................................... 49
Agricultural Quarantine Phytosanitary Certificates (Fees) Regulations ........ 52
Animal Quarantine (Fees) Regulations ............................................................... 52
Agricultural Quarantine (Prevention of Animal Disease) Regulations .......... 53
Plant Quarantine Regulations ............................................................................... 57

ARMS ACT 1974

Arms Registration (Fees) Regulations ................................................................. 67

BROADCASTING ACT 1989

Broadcasting Regulations ...................................................................................... 69

BUILDING CODE ACT 1992 .............................................................................. 73

BUSINESS LICENCE ACT 1997

Business Licence Regulations ............................................................................... 75

CHATTELS TRANSFER ACT 1924

Chattels Transfer Fees Regulations ...................................................................... 77

CHILD ALLOWANCE ACT 1995

Child Allowance (Fees) Regulations .................................................................... 79

CIVIL AVIATION ACT 1999 ............................................................................... 81

COMMUNICATIONS ACT

Radio Regulations ................................................................................................... 83
Telephone Regulations ........................................................................................... 108

CUSTOMS ACT 1966

Customs Regulations ............................................................................................. 123
Export Licences Regulations ................................................................................. 157
Export Prohibition Regulations ............................................................................ 160
Import Prohibition (Insecticides) Order .............................................................. 161
Import Prohibition (Offensive Weapons) Order ................................................ 161
Port and Service Tax Regulations ......................................................................... 162

CUSTOMS TARIFF ACT 1982

Customs Tariff (General Amendments) Regulations ........................................ 163
Customs Tariff (Reduction and Elimination of Tariffs) Regulations ............... 164

DEPARTURE TAX ACT 1996

Departure Travel Tax Regulations ........................................................................ 167

DIPLOMATIC PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES ACT 1968 ..................... 169

DOGS ACT 1966

Dogs (Fees) Regulations ........................................................................................ 171

DOMESTIC FISHING ACT 1995

Domestic Fishing Regulations .............................................................................. 173

ENTRY, RESIDENCE AND DEPARTURE TAX ACT 1985

Entry, Residence and Departure Regulations ..................................................... 179

ENVIRONMENT ACT 2003

Biosafety (Genetically Modified Organisms) Regulations ............................... 183

EXTRADITION ACT 1965 ................................................................................... 197

FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT ACT 1979

Film and Public Entertainment (Fees) Regulations ........................................... 199

GENERAL LAWS ACT 1968

Maritime Security Regulations ............................................................................. 201

INCORPORATED SOCIETIES ACT 1908

Incorporated Societies Regulations ...................................................................... 233

LIQUOR ACT 1975

Liquor (Breweries) Regulations ............................................................................ 237

MISUSE OF DRUGS ACT 1975 .......................................................................... 243

NIUE ACT 1966

Audit Regulations ................................................................................................... 245
Births and Deaths Registration Regulations ....................................................... 252
Co-operative Societies Regulations ...................................................................... 268
Dental Regulations ................................................................................................. 283
Gaming (Fees) Regulations ................................................................................... 284
High Court Rules .................................................................................................... 285
Land Court Rules .................................................................................................... 309
Land Registration Regulations ............................................................................. 327
Marriage Regulations ............................................................................................. 337
Penal Manual ........................................................................................................... 344
Sea Carriage of Goods Act 1940 ............................................................................ 364

NIUE BANK ACT 1994

Niue Bank Regulations .......................................................................................... 371

PARTNERSHIP ACT 1908

Partnership Amendment Fees Regulations ........................................................ 375

PARTNERSHIP APPLICATION ACT 1994

Partnership Amendment Forms Regulations ..................................................... 377

PENSIONS AND BENEFITS ACT 1991

Pensions and Benefits Regulations ...................................................................... 381

PUBLIC HEALTH ACT 1965

Notifiable Disease Notice ...................................................................................... 383

PUBLIC REVENUES ACT 1959

Treasury Rules ......................................................................................................... 385

TERRITORIAL SEA AND EXCLUSIVE ECONOMIC ZONE ACT 1997

Whale Sanctuary Regulations ............................................................................... 391

TRANSPORT ACT 1965

Transport (Fees) Regulations ................................................................................. 393

TRUSTEE ACT 1956

Trustees’ Commission Rules ................................................................................. 395

TRUSTEE COMPANIES ACT 1994 .................................................................... 399

UNITED NATIONS ACT 1946

United Nations Sanctions (Terrorism Suppression and Afghanistan
Measures) Regulations ........................................................................................... 401

VISITING FORCES ACT 1939

Visiting Forces (Commonwealth Deserters and Absentees) Order ................. 405
Visiting Forces Order .............................................................................................. 405
Visiting Forces (Penal Arrangements) Order ...................................................... 406
Visiting Forces (Relative Ranks) Regulations ..................................................... 407

WILDLIFE ACT 1972

Wildlife Protected Species Notice ......................................................................... 411
1

CONSTITUTION

NIUE ASSEMBLY STANDING ORDERS

Made by the Niue Assembly in accordance with article 22(1)

of the Constitution

20 Each Minister must take Oath of

Allegiance

PART 7

LANGUAGE THAT MAY BE USED IN THE ASSEMBLY

21 Language

PART 8

SEATING OF MEMBERS

22 Seating of members

PART 9

MEETINGS OF THE ASSEMBLY

23 Speaker to appoint time and place of

meetings of the Assembly

24 Members to attend sittings of the

Assembly

25 Grounds for granting leave of absence

26 Sittings

27 No Sunday sitting

28 Notice of meetings

29 Quorum of meetings of the Assembly

30 Meeting to start with Prayer

31 Broadcasting

PART 10

STRANGERS

32 Speaker controls admission

33 Strangers may be ordered to withdraw

34 Effect of order that strangers withdraw

35 Strangers interrupting proceedings

PART 11

DUTIES OF THE CLERK

36 Appointment of Clerk of the Niue

Assembly

37 Business Paper

38 Order Paper

39 Custody of records

40 Minutes

41 Record of members

42 Official report

2 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

76 Question fully put by the Speaker

77 Adjournment in case of grave disorder

78 Respect to be shown to the Speaker

PART 18

VOTING

79 Voting of members

PART 19

BILLS

80 Power of Assembly to make laws

81 Distribution of copies of Bills

82 Introduction of Bills into Assembly

83 Rules regarding Bills

84 Financial Bills

85 Bills affecting the Niue Public Service

86 Bills affecting Niuean land

87 Bills to be read three times in Assembly

88 Introduction and first reading of Bill

89 Procedure after first reading of Bill

90 Second reading of Bills

91 Procedure during debate on the motion that

a Bill be read a second time

92 Amendments to comply with certain

conditions

93 Postponement of consideration of a

clause

94 New clauses

95 Schedules

96 Adjournment during debate on the motion

that a Bill be read for a second time

97 Member may move that Bill be referred to

a select committee

98 Conclusion of debate on the motion that a

Bill be read a second time

99 Third Reading of Bills

100 Bill passed

101 Assent to Bills

102 Verbal or formal amendments

103 After certification

104 Withdrawal of Bills

105 Power of Assembly to send for persons,

papers and records

PART 20

APPROPRIATION BILLS

106 Procedure to be followed to enact

Appropriation Bills

107 Annual Appropriation Bill and estimates of

expenditure

108 Contents of Appropriation Bill

109 Contents of draft Estimate of Expenditure

and Financial Statement

110 Draft Estimate of Expenditure and Financial

Statement to be sent to each member

Constitution 3

111 Copy of budget statement to be provided to members

112 Consideration of Departmental votes

113 Third Reading to be taken immediately

after second reading

114 Appropriation Bill takes precedence over

other business

115 This Part to apply to Supplementary

Appropriation Bills

PART 21

SELECT COMMITTEES

116 Appointment of Select Committee

117 Control and dissolution of Select

Committee

118 Chairman of Committee

119 Quorum of Committee

120 Voting

121 Procedure of a Select Committee

PART 22

PECUNIARY INTERESTS OF MEMBERS TO BE DECLARED

122 Pecuniary interest defined

123 Members to declare pecuniary interests

124 Speaker decides if interest held

PART 23

TIME LIMIT OF SPEECHES

125 Time limit of speeches

PART 24

SUSPENSION OF STANDING ORDERS

126 Suspension of Standing Orders

1 Purpose

PART 1
INTRODUCTION
(1) These Standing Orders contain rules for the conduct of proceedings in the Niue Assembly and for the exercise of powers possessed by the Assembly.
(2) They are not intended to diminish or restrict the Assembly’s rights,
privileges, immunities and powers.

2 The rights, privileges, immunities and powers of the Assembly

[See article 24 of the Constitution]

3 Speaker to interpret Standing Orders

(1) The Speaker (or other person presiding) is responsible for ruling
whenever any question arises as to the interpretation or application of a Standing
Order and for deciding cases not otherwise provided for.
(2) In all cases the Speaker will be guided by previous Speakers’ rulings
and by the established practices of the Assembly.

4 Dress

(1) Members are expected to attend meetings of the Assembly attired in a
manner appropriate to the dignity of the Assembly.
(2) In particular men are expected to wear a coat and tie to attend a meeting
of the Assembly.
(3) The Speaker may exclude from a meeting of the Assembly a member
or any other person in the Assembly Chamber during a meeting of the Assembly
whom the Speaker does not consider to be suitably attired.

5 Smoking

(1) Members and other persons present during a meeting of the Assembly
are not permitted to smoke in the Assembly Chamber.
(2) The Speaker must direct a member or any other person who is smoking
in the Assembly Chamber during a meeting of the Assembly to stop smoking or
to leave the Chamber.
4 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

6 Speaker may order member to withdraw if grossly disorderly

(1) The Speaker may order a member whose conduct is grossly disorderly
to withdraw immediately from the Assembly during the remainder of that day’s
sitting.
(2) The Speaker may request a constable to assist in removing a member ordered to withdraw from the Assembly.

7 Definitions

PART 2
DEFINITIONS
(1) In these Standing Orders –
“absolute majority” at a meeting of the Niue Assembly, means an absolute
majority of the members present and voting at that meeting;
“Clerk” means the Clerk of the Niue Assembly and includes a person for
the time being performing the duties of the Clerk;
“meeting” means a sitting or sittings of the Assembly commencing when
the Assembly first meets after being summoned at any time and
terminating when the Assembly is adjourned –
(a) Until an indefinite time; or
(b) At the conclusion of a session;
“Paper” means a document which is ordinarily laid on the Table of the
Assembly at the time for “Presentation of Papers”;
“written” and “in writing” means written by hand, typewritten, duplicated,
or printed, or partly one or more of the others, and includes a
communication transmitted in facsimile or otherwise electronically.
(2) Words and phrases defined by article 82 of the Constitution and used
in these Standing Orders have the same meaning in these Standing Orders as they
do in the Constitution.
(3) The notes included in these Standing Orders do not form part of the
Standing Orders.
(4) These Standing Orders are to be interpreted as if they were an Act.

8 Election of the Speaker

PART 3
THE SPEAKER
If at the first meeting of the Assembly after a general election –
(a) The person presently holding the office of Speaker is not present,
or
(b) The office of Speaker is vacant,
the Clerk shall preside at the meeting until a Speaker is elected.
[See article 20(4) and (7) of the Constitution]

9 Qualifications required to be elected Speaker

[See article 20(2) and (3) of the Constitution]

10 Speaker to be elected by absolute majority

(1) The following procedure must be followed to elect the Speaker by an
absolute majority at a meeting of the Assembly –
(a) Any member may, on members being called upon to do so by the
person presiding at the meeting, nominate an eligible person for
election as the Speaker if that person’s consent in writing to being
nominated is produced;

Constitution 5

(b) No question is proposed on the election of the Speaker and no debate may arise in connection with it;
(c) If only one person is nominated for election as the Speaker the person presiding at the meeting must declare that person to be elected as the Speaker;
(d) If 2 people are nominated for election as the Speaker –
(i) A secret vote must be taken, and
(ii) If one person obtains more votes than the other the person
presiding at the meeting must declare that person to be elected
as the Speaker but if each receives the same number of votes
the person presiding at the meeting must again call for
nominations;
(e) If more than 2 people are nominated for election as the Speaker –
(i) A secret vote must be taken;
(ii) If a person receives the votes of an absolute majority of the
members the person presiding at the meeting must declare that
person to be elected as the Speaker;
(iii) If no person receives the votes of an absolute majority of the
members the candidate with the fewest number of votes is
eliminated and a secret vote must again be taken;
(iv) The procedure must be repeated until a person receives the
votes of an absolute majority of the members;
(v) If there are 2 candidates and each receive the same number of
votes the person presiding at the meeting must again call for
nominations and the whole election must be held again;
(f) If under paragraph (e)(iii) more than one candidate has the fewest
number of votes the vote must be taken again;
(g) If after the vote is retaken more than one candidate has the fewest
number of votes the person presiding at the meeting must determine
by lot which candidate is to be eliminated;
(h) If –
(i) There are no new nominations when nominations are called
for under paragraph (d) (ii); or
(ii) An election held under paragraph (e)(v) again results in 2
candidates receiving the same number of votes,
the person presiding at the meeting must determine by lot which
candidate is to be the Speaker.
(2) For the purpose of paragraph (1) a secret vote is to be held by –
(a) Each member writing on a piece of paper provided to the member
by the Clerk the name of the candidate for whom the member is
voting and handing the paper to the Clerk when requested to do so
by the Clerk; and
(b) Unless the Clerk is presiding at the meeting, the Clerk reporting
the result of the election to the person presiding at the meeting;
and
(c) The person presiding at the meeting announcing to the meeting
the number of votes received by each candidate; and
(d) The Clerk then destroying the papers received from the members.
[See article 20(1) of the Constitution]
6 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

11 Speaker to take oath

[See article 20(5) of the Constitution]

12 Vacation of office of Speaker

[See article 20(6) of the Constitution]

13 Presiding at meetings

[See article 22(2) of the Constitution]

14 Absence of Speaker

If at a meeting of the Assembly –
(a) The Speaker is absent; or
(b) The office of Speaker is vacant, the Clerk shall, for the purpose of
allowing the Assembly to comply with article 20(7) of the
Constitution, preside at the meeting until –
(i) The members present have elected one of their number to
preside over the meeting until the Speaker is again present; or
(ii) A Speaker is elected and has entered on the duties of his or her
office,
as the case may be.

15 Members to address the Speaker correctly

A member must address the Speaker as “Mr Speaker” or “Madam Speaker”,
as the case may be, during a sitting of the Assembly.
PART 4
OATH OF ALLEGIANCE

16 Oath of Allegiance to be taken by members.

[See article 20 of the Constitution]

17 Election of Premier

PART 5
THE PREMIER
[See article 4 of the Constitution]

18 Premier to be elected by absolute majority

(1) The following procedure must be followed to elect the Premier by an
absolute majority at a meeting of the Assembly –
(a) Any member may, on members being called upon to do so by the
Speaker, nominate another member for election as the Premier;
(b) No question is proposed on the election of the Premier and no debate
may arise in connection with it;
(c) If only one member is nominated for election as the Premier the
Speaker must declare that member to be elected as the Premier;
(d) If 2 members are nominated for election as the Premier –
(i) A secret vote must be taken;
(ii) If one member obtains more votes than the other the Speaker
must declare that member to be elected as the Premier but if
each receive the same number of votes the Speaker must again
call for nominations;

Constitution 7

(e) If more than 2 members are nominated for election as the Premier – (i) A secret vote must be taken;
(ii) If a member receives the votes of an absolute majority of the members the Speaker must declare that member to be elected as the Premier;
(iii) If no member receives the votes of an absolute majority of the
members the candidate with the fewest number of votes is
eliminated and a secret vote must again be taken;
(iv) The procedure must be repeated until a member receives the
votes of an absolute majority of the members;
(v) If there are 2 candidates and each receives the same number of
votes the Speaker must again call for nominations and the
whole election must be held again;
(f) If under paragraph (e)(iii) more than one candidate has the fewest
number of votes the vote must be taken again;
(g) If after the vote is retaken more than one candidate has the fewest
number of votes the Speaker must determine by lot which candidate
is to be eliminated;
(h) If –
(i) There are no new nominations when nominations are called
for under paragraph (d)(ii); or
(ii) An election held under paragraph (e)(v) again results in 2
candidates receiving the same number of votes,
the Speaker must determine by lot which candidate is to be the
Premier.
(2) For the purpose of paragraph (1) a secret vote is to be held by –
(a) Each member writing on a piece of paper provided to the member
by the Clerk the name of the candidate for whom the member is
voting and handing the paper to the Clerk when requested to do so
by the Clerk; and
(b) The Clerk reporting the result of the election to the Speaker; and
(c) The Speaker announcing to the meeting the number of votes
received by each candidate; and
(d) The Clerk then destroying the papers received from the members.
[Absolute majority means that if there are 20 members present and voting
a candidate must receive at least 11 votes to be elected, not just the most votes.]
PART 6
APPOINTMENT OF MINISTERS

19 Appointment of Ministers by the Premier

[See article 5 of the Constitution]

20 Each Minister must take Oath of Allegiance

[See article 10 of the Constitution]

21 Language

PART 7
LANGUAGE THAT MAY BE USED IN THE ASSEMBLY
[See article 23 of the Constitution]
8 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

22 Seating of members

PART 8
SEATING OF MEMBERS
(1) For the first meeting of the Assembly after a general election the Clerk must allocate a seat in the Assembly Chamber to each member in alphabetical order of each member ’s family name starting to the right of the Speaker ’s chair.
(2) After the Speaker has appointed the Premier and the 3 other Ministers they must occupy the seats immediately facing the Speaker ’s chair.
(3) The seats of the other members must be determined by each member
drawing a seat number from a container.
(4) The Speaker must determine any question that may arise with regard
to the seat to be occupied by a member.
(5) A member must not address the Assembly (through the Speaker) except
from the member ’s seat.
PART 9
MEETINGS OF THE ASSEMBLY

23 Speaker to appoint time and place of meetings of the Assembly

[See article 22(1) of the Constitution]

24 Members to attend sittings of the Assembly

A member must attend each sitting of the Assembly unless granted leave
of absence by the Speaker.

25 Grounds for granting leave of absence

The Speaker must not grant a member leave of absence except on the
following grounds –
(a) For illness or other family cause of a personal nature; or
(b) To enable the member to attend to other public business (whether
in Niue or overseas).

26 Sittings

(1) The Assembly sits on such days as are appointed by the Speaker.
(2) Unless the Assembly decides otherwise each sitting is to be from 9am
to 12 noon and from 1pm to 4pm.
(3) At 5 minutes before the appointed time to end a sitting the Speaker
must interrupt the business under discussion.
(4) Unless the Assembly otherwise decides, an adjournment of a sitting of
the Assembly is to the next working day.
(5) The Speaker may suspend a sitting at any time.

27 No Sunday sitting

The Assembly must not sit on a Sunday.

28 Notice of meetings

(1) The Clerk must give each member at least 5 working days written notice
of the commencement of a meeting of the Assembly.
(2) In an emergency the Speaker may summon a meeting of the Assembly
on such shorter notice as the circumstances require.
(3) If paragraph (2) applies notice of the meeting must be given to each
member in a way that will ensure the member is duly informed of the meeting.

Constitution 9

29 Quorum of meetings of the Assembly

(1) If at any time a quorum is not present the Speaker must direct each
member then present in the Fale Fono to be advised of the lack of a quorum.
(2) If at the end of 10 minutes a quorum is not present the Speaker must
adjourn the sitting without question put.
[See articles 22(6) and 20(9) of the Constitution]

30 Meeting to start with Prayer

Upon the Speaker taking the Chair each day and a quorum of members
being present the Speaker must call upon a member to say a Prayer.

31 Broadcasting

(1) The proceedings of the Assembly may be broadcast on radio or
television with the approval of the Speaker, which may be given subject to
conditions.
(2) A broadcast of the televised proceedings of the Assembly must maintain
such standards of fairness as are adopted, from time to time, by the Assembly.
PART 10
STRANGERS

32 Speaker controls admission

The Speaker –
(a) May control admission to the Chamber of the Assembly and its
lobbies and galleries; and
(b) May issue rules setting out who may be admitted to those areas
and governing their conduct there.

33 Strangers may be ordered to withdraw

(1) A member may move, without notice, “That strangers be ordered to
withdraw”.
(2) The Speaker must put the question without any amendment to or debate
on the question.

34 Effect of order that strangers withdraw

(1) If the Assembly resolves that strangers be ordered to withdraw –
(a) All strangers must leave the galleries; and
(b) All members of the press gallery must leave; and
(c) Official reporters and attendants must leave the Chamber and no
official report of the proceedings is to be made; and
(d) Broadcasting of debates is to cease.
(2) The Clerk must make a note of proceedings for the Journals of the
House.

35 Strangers interrupting proceedings

The Speaker may require strangers who interrupt proceedings or who
otherwise misconduct themselves, to leave the galleries and the precincts of the
Assembly Chamber.
10 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 11
DUTIES OF THE CLERK

36 Appointment of Clerk of the Assembly

[See article 27 of the Constitution]

37 Business Paper

The Clerk must at least 5 working days before the start of a meeting of the
Assembly send to each member a Business Paper setting out the business proposed
to be carried out by the Assembly during that meeting of the Assembly.

38 Order Paper

(1) The Clerk must give to each member before the start of a meeting a
paper (known as the Order Paper) setting out –
(a) The business proposed to be carried out by the Assembly during
that meeting; and
(b) The order in which it is intended to carry out that business.
(2) In general the business of the Assembly must be carried out in the
following order –
(a) Presentation of petitions;
(b) Tabling of papers;
(c) Consideration of papers;
(d) Questions for oral answers;
(e) Government business;
(f) Member ’s business.
(3) The Speaker may amend the Order Paper.

39 Custody of records

(1) The Clerk has the custody of the records and other documents belonging
to the Assembly.
(2) The records and other documents belonging to the Assembly –
(a) Must be made available by the Clerk upon request by a member;
and
(b) May be made available by the Clerk to any other person with the
permission of the Speaker.

40 Minutes

(1) The Clerk must –
(a) Keep minutes of the proceedings of the Assembly; and
(b) Send to each member a copy of the minutes of each meeting as
soon as possible after the conclusion of the meeting.
(2) The Clerk must record in the minutes of a meeting of the Assembly –
(a) The name of each member attending the meeting; and
(b) The decisions made by the Assembly during the meeting.
(3) The minutes must be signed by the Speaker and countersigned by the
Clerk.

41 Record of members

(1) The Clerk must keep a record in respect of each member.
(2) The record kept in respect of a member must include –
(a) The name of the member; and
(b) The date of his or her election; and
(c) The date the member took his or her seat; and
(d) On the member ceasing to be a member, the date and cause.

Constitution 11

42 Official report

(1) An official report (known as Hansard) is to be made by the Clerk of
those portions of the proceedings of the Assembly as is determined by the Assembly
or by the Speaker.
(2) The report is to be in such form and subject to such rules as are approved
from time to time by the Assembly or by the Speaker.
(3) The report must be published by the Clerk.

43 Presentation of Papers

PART 12
PAPERS
A Paper may be laid upon the Table of the Assembly when the Speaker calls for the “Presentation of Papers”.

44 Who may present Papers

(1) A Paper may be laid on the Table of the Assembly by –
(a) The Speaker; or
(b) A Minister; or
(c) The Chairman of a Select Committee.
(2) Otherwise a member has no power to lay a Paper on the Table of the
Assembly unless authorised to do so by a resolution of the Assembly.

45 Presentation of Papers

(1) The person in charge of a Paper may lay the Paper on the Table of the
Assembly without motion.
(2) A person who has laid a Paper on the Table of the Assembly may make
a short statement in respect of the Paper.
(3) The Speaker must not allow a debate on the statement.
(4) A Paper laid on the Table of the Assembly must be recorded as so laid
in the minutes of the meeting.

46 Consideration of Papers

(1) When a Paper has been laid on the Table of the Assembly the Clerk
must put it on the Business Paper for the next meeting of the Assembly.
(2) When “Consideration of Papers” is called on the Speaker must call the
title of each Paper in the order in which it appears on the Order Paper.
(3) If a member wants to debate a Paper the member may, on the Paper
being called on by the Speaker, move “That the Paper be noted” or “That the
Paper be referred to the Government for consideration” or some other motion
relevant to the Paper.
(4) If a motion is not made in respect of a Paper called on by the Speaker
for consideration the Clerk must omit mention of the Paper from subsequent Order
Papers.

47 Petitions

PART 13
PETITIONS
(1) A member may present a Petition to the Assembly if –
(a) It is made on a form provided for the purpose by the Clerk; and
(b) Each signature on the Petition is in the handwriting of the person
signing or, in the case of mark, it is witnessed; and
12 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(c) Each signature or mark is followed by the name and address of the person signing or making the mark; and
(d) The petition is in the Niuean or English language; and
(e) The petition is accompanied by a translation into the Niuean or
English language, as the case may be, certified as correct by the
Member who is to present the Petition.
(2) A Petition must not have any other document attached to it.

48 Presentation of Petition

When a member presents a Petition to the Assembly the member must
confine himself or herself to a brief statement of –
(a) A description of the group or people who signed the petition; and
(b) The number of signatures attached to it; and
(c) The general object of the Petitioner or Petitioners.

49 Disposal of Petition

(1) A member who has presented a Petition to the Assembly may then
move “That the petition be read” or “That the petition be referred to a Select
Committee”.
(2) In moving such a motion the member must give his or her reason for
doing so.

50 Petition on matter having judicial remedy

A member must not present a Petition to the Assembly in respect of matter
for which there is a judicial remedy if no application for that remedy has been
made.

51 Questions

PART 14
QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS
(1) A member may through the Speaker ask a question relating to a Bill, motion or other public matter connected with the business of the Assembly during the period set aside by the Assembly for questions and answers.
(2) The time allowed for questions, and answers in the Assembly shall be limited to 1 hour.

52 Notice of questions

(1) A question must not be asked without notice unless the Speaker is
satisfied that –
(a) It is of an urgent character; and
(b) Relates either to a matter of public importance or to the arrangement
of the business of the Assembly.
(2) A Member must give written notice of a question to the Clerk at least 3
working days before the day on which the answer is required.
(3) The questions in the Assembly at any one sitting shall be limited to 20
in number and shall be the first 20 questions received by the Office of the Speaker
by closing day, on a first come first served basis.
(4) Each question must be worded in the form of a single question and
must not include introductions or explanations.
(5) Questions will be distributed to Ministers no fewer than 3 working
days before the day on which the answer is required and will be listed in the
Order Paper on that day.

Constitution 13

53 Answers to questions

(1) The Speaker must not allow debate on a question that has been asked
and answered.
(2) As soon as a question has been answered in the Assembly the member
who asked the question may without notice, ask no more than 2 supplementary
questions.
(3) The Speaker must not permit a supplementary question to be asked
that introduces a matter not included in the original question.
(4) Each supplementary question must be worded in a form as a single
question and must not include introductions or explanations.

54 Notice of motions

PART 15
MOTIONS AND AMENDMENTS
(1) Except as provided in paragraph (2) a member who wants to move a motion in the Assembly must give notice of the motion the member proposes to move by giving a written copy of the motion to the Clerk at least 5 working days before the start of the meeting during which the member intends to move the motion.
(2) A member may move a motion without giving prior notice to the Clerk if it is a motion –
(a) By way of amendment to a question already proposed; or
(b) For the adjournment of the Assembly or of a debate; or
(c) Raising a question of privilege; or
(d) That a petition be read or referred to a Select Committee; or
(e) That a Bill be referred to a Select Committee; or
(f) That relates to a Paper called on for consideration; or
(g) To report progress; or
(h) For any reading of a Bill; or
(i) For the withdrawal of a Bill; or
(j) On a matter the Speaker accepts is urgent; or
(k) That does not require notice by virtue of any other provision of
these Standing Orders.

55 Form of motion

(1) A motion must be expressed in a form and with a content appropriate
for a resolution of the Assembly.
(2) Accordingly a motion must –
(a) Clearly indicate the issue to be raised for debate; and
(b) Include only such material as may be necessary to identify the facts
or matter to which the motion relates.
(3) A motion must not contain –
(a) Unbecoming or offensive expressions or expressions or words which
would not be permitted in debate, or
(b) Statements of fact or the names of persons unless –
(i) They are strictly necessary to render the motion intelligible;
and
(ii) can be authenticated.
14 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

56 Motions and amendments to be seconded

(1) A motion or amendment, unless made in Committee, must be moved
in the affirmative form and seconded.
(2) The mover of a motion or amendment may speak on the principle and
merits of the motion or amendment before formally moving the motion or
amendment but if it is not then seconded it lapses forthwith.

57 Motions to amend or replace Standing Orders

A notice of a motion to amend or replace these Standing Orders must be
accompanied by a draft of the proposed amendment or replacement Standing
Orders.

58 Withdrawal of motions and amendments

(1) A member who has proposed a motion or amendment may withdraw
it, but if the motion or amendment has been seconded the member cannot do so
except with the approval of the Assembly.
(2) A motion or amendment to which an amendment has been moved
cannot be withdrawn until the latter amendment has either been disposed of or
withdrawn.

59 Reintroduction of motions

A motion cannot be proposed which is the same in substance as a motion
that during the previous 12 months has been resolved in the affirmative or negative.

60 Moving of amendments to motions

(1) A proposed amendment to a motion cannot be moved until the Speaker
has accepted the motion.
(2) The Speaker must not accept a proposed amendment to a motion after
the vote on the motion has been taken.

61 Order of amendments to motions

When written notice has been given of several proposed amendments to a
motion, each proposed amendment is to be dealt with in the order in which, if
agreed to, it would stand in the amended motion.

62 Rules as to amendments to motions

A proposed amendment to a motion must be relevant to the motion.

63 Abuse of Standing Orders

The Speaker may decline to propose the question on a motion for the
adjournment of a debate or for the adjournment of the Assembly during a debate
if the Speaker is satisfied that the motion –
(a) Is an abuse of these Standing Orders; or
(b) An infringement of the rights of the minority of members.
PART 16
PERSONAL EXPLANATIONS

64 Personal explanations

(1) A member may with the leave of the Speaker at the time appointed for
Personal Explanations explain matters of a personal nature.
(2) The Speaker must not allow a personal explanation to be debated.
(3) The subject matter of a proposed personal statement must first be
communicated to the Speaker.

Constitution 15

PART 17
RULES OF DEBATE

65 Members to address the Speaker

A member must not address the Assembly except through the Speaker.

66 The Speaker to call upon member to speak

(1) A member who wishes to speak must raise his or her arm to attract the
Speaker ’s attention.
(2) The Speaker should generally permit members to speak in the order in
which they catch the eye of the Speaker.

67 Speaker to be heard in silence

When the Speaker is addressing the Assembly –
(a) Any member then speaking must immediately cease speaking; and
(b) All members must remain silent to permit the Speaker to be heard
without interruption.

68 Speech to be directed to the question

(1) A member must speak to the subject matter under discussion.
(2) The Speaker may –
(a) Call the attention of the Assembly to continued irrelevance or
tedious repetition on the part of a member who is at that time
speaking; and
(b) Direct the member to discontinue his or her speech.

69 Member generally to be allowed to speak once

(1) Except as provided by paragraphs (2) and (4) and during debate on the
second reading of a Bill, the Speaker must ensure that a member speaks only once
to a question.
(2) The Speaker may allow a member who has spoken to speak again to
clear up a misunderstanding in regard to a material point of the member ’s speech.
(3) In allowing the member to speak again the Speaker must not allow the
member to –
(a) Introduce new matter; or
(b) Interrupt a member who is speaking.
(4) The Speaker may allow the mover of a substantive motion or
amendment a right of reply but must ensure that the reply is confined to matters
raised during the debate.
(5) The reply of the mover of a motion or proposed amendment closes the
debate on the motion or the amendment and the Speaker must not permit any
other member to speak or move a proposed amendment in respect of the motion.

70 Member may speak to Point of Order

A member may speak –
(a) To a point of order; or
(b) Upon a matter of privilege suddenly arising.

71 Point of Order takes precedence

(1) A point of order being raised takes precedence.
(2) Any member who is speaking when a point of order is raised must
cease speaking until the Speaker has given a ruling on the point of order.
16 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

72 Offensive words

The Speaker must intervene if offensive or disorderly words are used
whether by a member who is speaking or by a member who is present.

73 Personal reflection

The Speaker must intervene if a member makes –
(a) An imputation of an improper motive against a member; or
(b) An offensive reference to a member ’s private affairs; or
(c) A personal reflection against a member.

74 Matters awaiting judicial decision

(1) If it appears to the Speaker that there is a real and substantial danger of
prejudice to a matter awaiting or under adjudication in a court the Speaker may
order a member not to refer to the matter in –
(a) A motion; or
(b) A debate; or
(c) A question, including a supplementary question.
(2) Paragraph (1) has effect –
(a) In relation to a criminal matter, from when a charge is made; and
(b) In relation to any other matter, from when proceedings are initiated
by the filing of the appropriate document in the registry or office of
the court.
(3) Paragraph (1) ceases to have effect when the verdict and sentence are
announced or from when judgment is given in respect of the matter, as the case
may be.
(4) If notice of appeal is given paragraph (1) has effect from when that
notice is given until the appeal is decided.
(5) Paragraph (1) is subject to the right of the Assembly to legislate on any
matter.

75 Closure of debate

(1) At any time after a motion or amendment has been proposed a member
may move “That the question be now put”.
(2) Unless it appears to the Speaker that the motion –
(a) Is an abuse of these Standing Orders; or
(b) Is an infringement of the rights of the minority of members, the
Speaker must forthwith put the motion “That the question be now
put”.
(3) If the motion is carried the Speaker must put the question on the
substantive motion or amendment without further debate.

76 Question fully put by the Speaker

A member must not speak to a question after –
(a) It has been fully put by the Speaker; and
(b) The vote on the question has been given both in the affirmative
and negative.

77 Adjournment in case of grave disorder

If the Speaker thinks it necessary to do so because of grave disorder in the
Assembly the Speaker may –
(a) Adjourn the Assembly without question put; or
(b) Suspend the sitting until a time or for a period specified by the
Speaker.

Constitution 17

78 Respect to be shown to the Speaker

A member who leaves the Assembly Chamber during a sitting must show
respect to the Speaker both on leaving and on return to his or her seat.

79 Voting of members

Part 18
VOTING
(1) Except as otherwise provided by these Standing Orders, the Speaker determines if voting on a question before the Assembly is to be –
(a) On the voices; or
(b) By a show of hands; or
(c) By a secret ballot held in a manner determined by the Speaker.
(2) If the Speaker is presiding at the time of a vote on a question and there
is an equality of votes the question is lost.
(3) The Speaker declares the result of a vote.
[See articles 22(3)(4)(5) and article 35(1) of the Constitution]
PART 19
BILLS

80 Power of Assembly to make laws

[See article 28 of the Constitution]

81 Distribution of copies of Bills

(1) The Clerk must send a copy of a Bill to each member at least 10 days
before the first reading of the Bill.
(2) A Bill specified in a Certificate of Urgency signed by the Speaker may
be introduced without prior distribution to members.

82 Introduction of Bills into Assembly

[See article 29 of the Constitution]

83 Rules regarding bills

(1) A Bill introduced into the Assembly must be accompanied by an
explanatory note signed by the member who introduced the Bill.
(2) The explanatory note must state the objects and reasons for the Bill.
(3) A Bill must have a distinguishing title.
(4) A Bill must be divided into successive clauses consecutively numbered,
and each clause must have a head note giving a short indication of the content of
the clause.

84 Financial Bills

The procedure for passing Appropriation Bills is subject to the additional
requirements set out in Part 20.
[See article 30 of the Constitution]

85 Bills affecting the Niue Public Service

[See article 32(1) of the Constitution]

86 Bills affecting Niuean land

[See article 33(1) of the Constitution]
18 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

87 Bills to be read three times in Assembly

[See article 22(8) of the Constitution]

88 Introduction and first reading of Bill

(1) A member may introduce a Bill to the Assembly by –
(a) Reading its Long Title; and
(b) Explaining the purpose and general intent of the Bill.
(2) After introducing the Bill the member introducing the Bill must move
“That the [short title of Bill] be read a first time”.
(3) On the motion being made and seconded “That the [short title of Bill]
be read a first time” the debate on that motion must be confined to the principles
and general merits of the Bill.

89 Procedure after first reading of Bill

If the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a first time” is carried the
member in charge of the Bill must move “That the [short title of Bill] be read a
second time”.

90 Second reading of Bills

On the motion being made and seconded “That the [short title of Bill] be
read a second time” the Speaker must not allow any amendment to the motion
except an amendment to postpone the second reading of the Bill to some
subsequent date.

91 Procedure during debate on the motion that a Bill be read a second time

(1) During debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a
second time” the member in charge of the Bill must –
(a) Call the number of each clause of the Bill in succession; and
(b) Read the headnote to the clause.
(2) When the member in charge of the Bill has read the headnote to a clause
of the Bill –
(a) That member may provide an explanation in respect of the clause;
and
(b) Other members may speak in respect of the clause.
(3) If no amendment is offered in respect of a clause the Speaker must put
the question “That clause [number of the clause] stands part of the Bill”.
(4) If a clause is amended the Speaker must put the question “That clause
[number of the clause] as amended stands part of the Bill”.
(5) Notice need not be given of a motion to amend a clause nor does such
a motion need to be seconded.
(6) A member may speak more than once in respect of a clause or on a
proposed amendment to a clause but when more than one member indicates a
wish to speak the Speaker must give preference to a member who has not
previously spoken.

92 Amendments to comply with certain conditions

(1) During debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a
second time” the Speaker must refuse to put to the Assembly any amendment the
Speaker considers does not comply with the following conditions –
(a) The amendment must be relevant to the subject matter of the Bill
and to the subject matter of the clause (if any) to which it relates;
and

Constitution 19

(b) The amendment must not be such as to make the clause (if any) it proposes to amend unintelligible or ungrammatical; and
(c) If an amendment refers to or is not intelligible without a subsequent amendment, notice of the subsequent amendment is given before or when the first amendment is moved so as to make the series of amendments intelligible.
(2) The Speaker must not accept a motion by a member to delete the whole of a clause since the proper course for the member to take is to vote against the clause.

93 Postponement of consideration of a clause

During debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a second
time” the consideration of a clause may on motion be postponed.

94 New clauses

(1) During debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a
second time” any member may propose a new clause for the Bill.
(2) Any proposed new clause must be considered when the appropriate
place for the insertion of the clause into the Bill is reached.

95 Schedules

(1) During debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a
second time” any member may propose a new schedule for the Bill.
(2) Any proposed new schedule must be considered when the appropriate
place for the insertion of the schedule into the Bill is reached.

96 Adjournment during debate on the motion that a Bill be read for a second time

(1) If the consideration of a Bill by the Assembly on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a second time” is not completed at the one time the consideration of the Bill may, on motion made, be adjourned until –
(a) The next sitting day; or
(b) Some subsequent sitting day or meeting of the Assembly.
(2) When the time appointed for the resumption of debate on the motion
“That the [short title of Bill] be read a second time” arrives the Assembly must
resume debate on that motion.

97 Member may move that Bill be referred to a select committee

(1) At any time during debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill]
be read a second time” a member may move “That the [short title of Bill] be
considered by the [name of appropriate Select Committee]”.
(2) If a Bill is referred to a Select Committee no further proceedings are to
be taken on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a second time” until
the Select Committee has reported to the Assembly.
(3) When consideration of a Bill by a Select Committee has been completed
the member in charge of the Bill must report to the Assembly.
(4) The report must state “Mr Speaker I beg to report that the [short title of
Bill] has been considered by the [name of Select Committee] and has been approved
[with] or [without] amendment”.
(5) Where the Bill has been approved by the Select Committee with
amendments the member in charge of the Bill must move “That the amendments
to the [short title of Bill] approved by the [name of Select Committee] stand part
of the Bill”.
20 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(6) The Assembly may approve all or any of the amendments proposed by the Select Committee or reject them, and may continue the debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a second time”.

98 Conclusion of debate on the motion that a Bill be read a second time

When the consideration of the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read
a second time” has been completed the Speaker must put to the Assembly the
question “That the [title of Bill] [as amended – if amended during debate on the
second reading] be read a second time”.

99 Third Reading of Bills

Upon motion being made and seconded “That the [title of Bill] [as amended
– if amended during debate on the second reading of the Bill] be read a third
time” amendments for the correction of errors or oversights may with the Speaker’s
permission be made but no amendments of a material character are to be accepted
by the Speaker.
[See article 35(1) of the Constitution]

100 Bill passed

After a Bill has been read a third time –
(a) The Bill is to be taken to have been passed by the Assembly; and
(b) Accordingly the Speaker must not put to the Assembly any further
question in respect of the Bill.

101 Assent to Bills

(1) When a Bill (other than a Bill to which article 35 of the Constitution
applies) has been passed by the Assembly the Clerk must prepare at least 2 copies
of the Bill for certification under article 34 of the Constitution.
(2) When a Bill to which article 35 of the Constitution applies –
(a) Has been passed by the Assembly under that article; and
(b) Has been submitted to a poll and received the support prescribed
by that article,
the Clerk must prepare at least 2 copies of the Bill to be certified under that article.

102 Verbal or formal amendments

In preparing a Bill for certification in accordance with article 34 or 35 of the
Constitution the Clerk may –
(a) Make amendments of a verbal or formal nature; and
(b) Correct clerical, typographical or cross-reference errors.

103 After certification

When a Bill has been certified in accordance with article 34 or 35 of the
Constitution, the Clerk must –
(a) Retain one certified copy of the Bill with the records of the Assembly;
and
(b) Deposit one certified copy of the Bill with the Attorney-General.

104 Withdrawal of Bills

A member in charge of a Bill may by motion without notice withdraw the
Bill from the Assembly.

Constitution 21

105 Power of Assembly to send for persons, papers and records

During debate on the motion “That the [short title of Bill] be read a second
time” the Assembly may approve a motion to require –
(a) The department of Government concerned; or
(b) An outside person or body –
(i) to submit a report to explain a provision of the Bill; or
(ii) to depute a representative to appear as a witness before the
Assembly to explain a provision of the Bill.
[These Standing Orders only bind the Speaker and Members of the Niue
Assembly (although even here the Assembly may, in any particular case, suspend
their application). They do not bind other people. So it is not an offence for a
person to fail to comply with a requirement made under this Order. To make it an
offence the Assembly would need to pass legislation setting out the powers and
privileges of the Assembly. Such legislation is provided for by article 24(5) of the
Constitution.]
PART 20
APPROPRIATION BILLS

106 Procedure to be followed to enact Appropriation Bills

The procedure for passing Appropriation Bills is the same as for passing
other Bills as set out in Part 19 subject to the variations and additional requirements
set out in this Part.
[See article 30 of the Constitution]

107 Annual Appropriation Bill and estimates of expenditure

[See articles 58 and 59(1) of the Constitution]

108 Contents of Appropriation Bill

The Appropriation Bill for a financial year must contain –
(a) An estimate of the expenditure to be made from the Niue
Government Account for all the services of Government for that
financial year (other than expenditure for a service of Government
authorised by any other law); and
(b) A Schedule specifying the amount of that expenditure appropriated
to each department of Government for that financial year.

109 Contents of draft Estimate of Expenditure and Financial Statement

(1) Details of the amount appropriated by the Appropriation Bill to each
department of Government for the financial year must be contained in a draft
Estimate of Expenditure and Financial Statement.
(2) The draft Estimate of Expenditure and the Financial Statement for a
financial year must also –
(a) Show expenditure for a service of Government authorised by any
other law; and
(b) Contain an estimate of the revenue to be received by each
department of Government during the financial year.

110 Draft Estimate of Expenditure and Financial Statement to be sent to each member

The draft Estimate of Expenditure and the Financial Statement for a financial year must be sent to each Member at the same time as the Appropriation Bill is sent to members.
22 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

111 Copy of budget statement to be provided to members

If the Minister in charge of an Appropriation Bill intends to read a budget
statement on moving “That the Appropriation Bill be read a first time” the Minister
must before making that statement provide each Member with a copy of it either
in the Niuean language or the English language, as requested by the member.

112 Consideration of Departmental votes

(1) During debate on the motion “That the Appropriation Bill be read a
second time” the clauses of the Bill stand postponed until after the consideration
of the Schedule to the Bill.
(2) On consideration of the Schedule to an Appropriation Bill the Minister
in charge of the Bill must call the title of each department of Government in turn
and propose the question “That the sum of $[amount] for the [name of Department
of Government] Departmental Vote stands part of the Schedule”.
(3) A member may move an amendment to reduce the sum appropriated
for an item in a Departmental Vote by proposing the question “That the sum
appropriated to item [item number as contained in the draft Estimate of
Expenditure and Financial Statement] in the [name of Department] Departmental
Vote be reduced by $[amount].
(4) When several such amendments are proposed to reduce the amount
appropriated to various items in a Departmental Vote –
(a) They must be called in the numerical order of the vote items as
contained in the draft Estimate of Expenditure and Financial
Statement; and
(b) If there is more than one amendment to the same item, the larger
reduction must be put first.
(5) An increase in the sum appropriated for an item in a Departmental
Vote cannot be moved except by the Minister in charge of the Bill and then only
with the consent of the Premier.
(6) If an amendment is moved to increase an amount appropriated to an
item in a Departmental Vote –
(a) It takes priority over any amendment to decrease the amount
appropriated to the item; and
(b) If carried, any amendment to decrease the amount appropriated
to the item lapses.
(7) When all amendments in respect of a Departmental Vote have been
disposed of, the Speaker must propose the questions “That the sum) or reduced
or increased sum of $[amount] for [name of Department of Government]
Departmental Vote stands part of the Schedule”.
(8) When each Departmental Vote in the Schedule to an Appropriation
Bill has been dealt with the Speaker must call each clause of the Bill.
(9) When calling a clause the Speaker must indicate to members any
consequential amendment to the amount specified in the clause as a result of any
change in an amount appropriated in respect of a department of Government.

113 Third Reading to be taken immediately after Second Reading

(1) When an Appropriation Bill has been read a second time the third
reading of the Bill must be taken forthwith.
(2) The Speaker must not allow any debate on the motion for the third
reading of an Appropriation Bill.

Constitution 23

114 Appropriation Bill takes precedence over other business

An Appropriation Bill takes precedence over all other business.

115 This Part to apply to Supplementary Appropriation Bills

This Part applies to a Supplementary Appropriation Bill in the same way
as it applies to an Appropriation Bill.
PART 21
SELECT COMMITTEES

116 Appointment of Select Committee

(1) The Assembly may –
(a) Appoint a Select Committee consisting of members; and
(b) Refer to the Committee a matter for consideration or enquiry and
report.
(2) A matter referred to a Select Committee may include –
(a) Any proposed Bill submitted to it by a Minister before its approval
by the Government and its introduction into the Assembly; and
(b) Any proposals for public expenditure (with any estimates of
revenue) submitted to it by the Minister responsible for finance
before their approval by the Government and the introduction into
the Assembly of a Bill to authorise that expenditure.
(3) In respect of a matter referred to it by a Minister a Select Committee
must report to that Minister.

117 Control and dissolution of Select Committees

A Select Committee is subject to the control of the Assembly and
accordingly –
(a) May be dissolved by the Assembly; or
(b) Have its functions transferred by the Assembly to another
Committee appointed by the Assembly.

118 Chairman of Committee

(1) A Select Committee must elect a Chairman before proceeding to any
other business.
(2) A Chairman so elected holds office during the life of the Committee
unless the members of the Committee otherwise determine.
(3) A Chairman of a Select Committee may call a meeting of the Committee
at any time the Chairman is satisfied there is a matter to be considered by the
Committee.

119 Quorum of Committee

The quorum of a Select Committee, unless otherwise ordered by the
Assembly, is half of the members appointed to the Committee.

120 Voting

(1) A question before a Select Committee is to be decided by a majority of
votes of the members present.
(2) A Chairman of a Committee has a deliberative and, if there is an equality
of votes, a casting vote.
24 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

121 Procedure of a Select Committee

Except as otherwise provided by this Part, Standing Orders applicable
during the debate on the second reading of a Bill apply to a Select Committee.
PART 22
PECUNIARY INTERESTS OF MEMBERS TO BE DECLARED
[See article 119 of the Constitution]

122 Pecuniary interest defined

(1) A pecuniary interest is a direct financial benefit that might accrue to a
member personally, or to any trust, company or other business entity in which the
member holds an appreciable interest, as a result of the outcome of the Assembly’s
consideration of a particular item of business.
(2) A pecuniary interest –
(a) Includes a pecuniary interest held by a member ’s spouse or
domestic partner or by any child of the member who is wholly or
mainly dependent on the member for support, but
(b) Does not include any interest held by a member or any other person
as one of a class of persons who belong to a profession, vocation or
other calling or who hold public offices or an interest held in
common with the public.

123 Members to declare pecuniary interests

A member must, before participating in the consideration of an item of
business, declare any pecuniary interest that the member has in that business.

124 Speaker decides if interest held

If a dispute arises as to whether a member has a pecuniary interest, the
matter is to be determined by the Speaker, whose decision is final.
PART 23
TIME LIMIT OF SPEECHES

125 Time limit of speeches

(1) The Speaker must limit the time allowed for a speech in the Assembly
as follows –

Matter

Time limit in minutes

A Bill, motion, amendment or the

Consideration of a Paper –

The mover

Another member

15

10

Report of Select Committee

10

Presentation of Petition

5

Presentation of Papers

5

Replies to Questions

5

Constitution 25

(2) These limitations do not apply to a member in charge of an
Appropriation Bill delivering the first reading speech in respect of the Bill.
(3) Subject to leave of the Assembly, a member may be granted an extension
of time not exceeding half the time allotted to him or her under paragraph (1).
PART 24
SUSPENSION OF STANDING ORDERS

126 Suspension of Standing Orders

(1) A member may with the consent of the Speaker move a motion with or
without notice “That Standing Order [number of Standing Order] be suspended
[wholly or in part or as appropriate].
(2) The Speaker must not give approval under paragraph (1) unless 10
members are present at the time the motion is to be moved.
26 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

PUBLIC SERVICE REGULATIONS 2004

2004/4 – 15 July 2004

1 Name

2 Interpretation

GENERAL

3 Purposes and achievement of Service goals

4 Manual of Instructions

5 Access to Regulations and Manual

6 Code of conduct

7 Appointment of employee as a member of

VACANCIES, ADVERTISEMENTS, APPOINTMENTS, STATUS AND TENURE OF EMPLOYEES

15 Establishment of positions

16 Vacancies

17 Educational qualifications for appointment

18 Medical examination and retirement for

medical reasons

19 Criteria for appointment

20 Form of appointment

21 Effective date of appointment and

promotion

22 Appointment to specified offices

23 Statutory declaration

24 Permanent employees

25 Probation

26 Contract employee

27 Temporary employee

28 Cessation of employment

29 Retirement from the Service

30 Re-employment

CANDIDACY AND MEMBERSHIP OF THE NIUE

ASSEMBLY OR VILLAGE COUNCIL

31 Candidacy

32 Membership of the Assembly or Village

Council

GRADING AND PROMOTION

33 Permanent positions to be graded

34 Determination and allocation of grades in

the Service

35 Application for review of grading

GENERAL CONDITIONS OF EMPLOYMENT

38 List of employees

39 Allowances

40 Hours of attendance

41 Additional hours of duty

42 Records of attendance

43 Absence from place of employment

44 Care of government stores and property

45 Accounts and government money

46 Borrowing and lending of government

money and property

47 Liability or commitment not to be incurred

48 Secondary employment and participation

in private business

49 Service on statutory authorities

50 Conflict of interest

51 Restrictions on remuneration

52 Solicitation, acceptance of gifts or bribery

53 Restriction on official information

54 Outside influence

55 Transfer and redeployment of employee

56 Rent for accommodation

57 Authority to take money for unpaid debt

to the Government

LEAVE

58 Annual leave

59 Special leave

60 Maternity leave

61 Paternity leave

62 Contract and temporary employee leave

63 Retiring leave

64 Payment for leave on death of employee

65 Sick leave

66 Long service leave

67 Bereavement leave

68 Public holidays

69 Forfeiture of employment

DISCIPLINARY PROVISIONS

70 Compliance with instructions and

employee complaints

71 Unsatisfactory performance

72 Allegations for disciplinary action

73 Disciplinary proceedings

74 Conviction for offence

Constitution 27

75

Penalties

81

Appeals Committee procedures

76

Suspension

82

Appeal decision

77

Incriminating questions

TRANSITIONAL AND REPEAL PROVISIONS

APPEALS

83

Transitional provision

78

Right of appeal of permanent employee

79

Situation where no appeal lies

SCHEDULE

80

Appeals Committee

Pursuant to article 68 of the Constitution the Niue Public Service

Commission, with the approval of Cabinet, makes the following Regulations

1 Name

GENERAL
These are the Public Service Regulations 2004.

2 Interpretation

(1) Expressions in these Regulations have the same meaning as they have
in the Constitution.
(2) In these Regulations –
“actual service” means the period of an employee’s employment in the
Service, including any period of authorised paid leave, but does not
include any period of voluntary leave without pay or any period of
broken service;
“Appeals Committee” means the Appeals Committee referred to in
regulation 80;
“broken service” means any situation where an employee has ceased to be
a member of the Service and is subsequently re-employed;
“certificate of employment” means a statement in writing of the work record
in the Service of an employee;
“consequential vacancy” means a position that becomes vacant immediately
following the appointment of an employee to fill another position or
an advertised vacancy;
“continuous service” means an uninterrupted period of employment
including any period of authorised leave;
“contract employee” means a person employed on a contract of service
under regulation 26;
“contributory service” means the period during which an employee
contributes to a superannuation scheme or fund approved by the
Commission, including any period of previous service the employee
elects to include in contributions to the superannuation scheme or fund;
“controlling officer” in relation to an employee, means the person who is
for the time being in charge of that employee and authorised to require
that employee to do or abstain from doing any act or thing;
“Department” means each separate organisation or office of the Service;
“employee” means any person employed in the Service as a permanent
employee, a probationer, a contract employee, or a temporary employee;
“healthy” means not harmful;
“Manual” means the Manual of Instructions 1983 issued by the Commission
under article 68(2) of the Constitution or regulation 4 and includes any
updated Manual;
28 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
“Official Circular” means the Niue Public Service Official Circular issued by the Commission;
“permanent employee” means an employee other than a probationer, or a contract employee, or a temporary employee;
“probationer” means a person employed on probation under regulation
25;
“redeployment” means the release of an employee by the Commission from
normal duties for a specified period to undertake work on a community
project, or other duties outside the Service, approved by the
government;
“Service” means the Niue Public Service;
“Service Organisation” means the Niue Public Service Association
Incorporated;
“specified office” means the office of Secretary to the Government, of High
Commissioner to New Zealand, or of Head of Department, or of a
medical or legal officer, or of an accountant or teacher or of any other
similar office for which a tertiary-level qualification is required;
“temporary employee” means a person employed in a temporary or
relieving capacity under regulation 27;
“transfer” means the moving of an employee by the Commission from one
position in the Service to another, either within a department, or to
another department, as a disciplinary measure, with or without
promotion, following a request of the employee, or for some other
reason consistent with the purposes of these Regulations.

3 Purposes and achievement of Service goals

(1) The purposes of these Regulations are –
(a) To provide standards of service for all departments and offices of
the executive government;
(b) To promote the efficiency, effectiveness and economy and
harmonious functioning of all departments and offices of the
executive government by –
(i) procuring the application of quality technical and professional
knowledge, methods, system and practice;
(ii) avoiding extravagance and waste;
(iii) aiming at high quality work and output;
(iv) controlling the volume of the work performed;
(v) training, up-skilling and re-skilling of employees;
(vi) maintaining a proper standard of conduct and ethics by
employees;
(vii) encouraging employees, through incentives, to submit
suggestions for increasing the efficiency, effectiveness or
economy of the Service, and decreasing the cost and volume of
work of the State;
(c) To promote mutual trust and confidence in all aspects of the
employment relationship which must be built on good faith
behaviour.
(2) In all cases these Regulations shall be interpreted consistently with the
purposes set out in regulation 3 and with a view to achieving those purposes.

Constitution 29

4 Manual of Instructions

(1) The Commission must produce and publish an updated Manual of
Instructions at regular intervals.
(2) All terms and conditions for employees must be consistent with the
Constitution and with these Regulations.
(3) Additional instructions, and amendments of, or revocations to existing
instructions shall be published in the Official Circular or in such other manner as
the Commission thinks fit.
(4) Every head of department must ensure copies of these Regulations and
the Manual in their possession are in secure custody and are kept up to date.

5 Access to Regulations and Manual

(1) The Commission must supply departments with sufficient copies of
Part VI of the Constitution, these Regulations and the Manual, and the head of
every department must ensure these documents are readily available for employees
to read.
(2) Every employee is deemed to have notice of, and must comply with,
all instructions, directions and conditions of employment contained in Part VI of
the Constitution, these Regulations, the Manual, the Official Circular, or which
have been communicated to the employee in any other manner.

6 Code of conduct

The Commission must establish and maintain a code of minimum standards
of conduct for the Service, reflecting the following principles of conduct –
(a) In assisting the Cabinet in exercising the executive authority of Niue,
under article 62 of the Constitution, employees must act with
professionalism and political neutrality;
(b) Employees must perform their official duties honestly, faithfully
and efficiently, respecting the rights of the public and those of their
colleagues;
(c) Employees must not bring the Service into disrepute through their
private activities.

7 Appointment of employee as a member of the Commission

Where an employee is appointed as a member of the Commission the
employee must take leave of absence from the Service for the period of membership
of the Commission.

8 Inspection

(1) The Commission may appoint and authorise any person (employed in
the Service or otherwise) to inspect any department, employee or class of employee.
(2) The person making the inspection shall report on –
(a) The efficiency, effectiveness and economy of the department
inspected, or the performance of the employee or class of employees;
and,
(b) Specify in the report any changes and measures considered
necessary to improve the efficiency, effectiveness and economy of
the department, or to improve the performance of the employee or
class of employees.
(3) Any report arising from the inspection of a department in relation to
its functions and responsibilities must be referred to Cabinet for its information.
30 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

9 Notice to employees

Where under these Regulations any notice is required to be given to an
employee in respect of any decision or other matter, it is (except in the case specified
in regulation 69) sufficient compliance with that requirement if the notice is
published in the Official Circular or is sent to the employee by letter or by facsimile
to the employee’s place of employment or last known place of abode.

10 Representation by the Service Organisation

(1) The Service Organisation, without prejudice to the right of any employee
to act on his own behalf, may make representations to the Commission on any
matter affecting the conditions of employment of an employee, or class of
employee.
(2) In making a decision on any matter, the Commission must give due
consideration to representations made by the Service Organisation, or by an
employee, in addition to any other consideration that the Commission thinks fit.
(3) The Service Organisation must, as far as possible, endeavour to discuss
all its concerns and grievances with the Commission.

11 Industrial action unlawful

(1) No employee shall participate in any form of industrial action or refuse
to perform duties as lawfully directed by the Commission or act or conspire to act
in any way that would adversely affect the provision, the adequacy and quality of
essential services or any work primarily the responsibility and duty of the employee
to carry out.
(2) Any employee who acts in breach of this regulation is deemed to have
forfeited office forthwith and the Commission must inform the employee
accordingly.

12 Essential services

(1) “Essential services” includes –
(a) The supply of electric power and water, sanitation and plumbing
services, and other public utilities;
(b) The provision of medical, dental and associated or support services;
(c) The maintenance of law and order;
(d) Teaching and the provision of other services related to education;
(e) The provision of fire and rescue services (sea and land);
(f) The provision of transport services by air, land or sea;
(g) The provision of border control services such as customs, health,
immigration, quarantine, and security;
(h) The provision of telecommunications and postal services, both
internal and external;
(i) The provision of meteorological services;
(j) The provision of fuel and oil;
(k) The provision of administrative, economic, financial, legal and
planning advice, and corporate support services;
(l) Any other service as determined by the Cabinet.
(2) The minimum level and quality of essential services to be provided by
the Service are such as determined by the Cabinet in consultation with the
Commission.

Constitution 31

13 Occupational safety and health

The Commission must take all practical steps to ensure the safety and health
of employees while at work, and in particular must take practical steps to –
(a) Provide and maintain a safe and healthy working environment;
and
(b) Provide and maintain facilities for safety and health; and
(c) Provide safety and health awareness information and instruction
programmes; and
(d) Develop procedures for dealing with emergencies.

14 Advice and counselling

The Commission must take practical steps to provide work related advice
and counselling to employees on matters affecting their individual employment,
including their health and welfare in relation to their employment.
VACANCIES, ADVERTISEMENTS, APPOINTMENTS, STATUS AND TENURE OF EMPLOYEES

15 Establishment of positions

(1) The Public Service shall comprise such positions as are publicly notified
from time to time by the Commission.
(2) The Commission may, with the approval of Cabinet, establish or
disestablish any position within the Service.
(3) The Commission shall, on the advice of Cabinet, and subject to article
69 of the Constitution, establish or disestablish any position within the Service.

16 Vacancies

(1) The Commission may fill any vacancy –
(a) With an employee from within the Service by way of transfer, either
with or without promotion provided that only a transfer or
promotion will be subject to an open right of appeal; or,
(b) By advertising the vacancy within or outside the Service, or both;
or,
(c) By making an appointment to a consequential vacancy from among
the unsuccessful candidates who applied for an advertised vacancy;
and, where an appointment made in this manner involves
promotion, it will be subject to appeal but only by those who applied
for the advertised vacancy.
(2) If the Commission advertises a vacancy it must –
(a) Publish the advertisement in the Official Circular or in some other
suitable manner;
(b) Provide at least 14 days between the date of the first advertisement
for a vacancy and the deadline for receipt of applications for that
vacancy.
(3) Every application for a vacancy must be in writing and shall include
all such information as the Commission requires as specified in any advertisement.

17 Educational qualifications for appointment

The Commission may specify a standard of education required as a
minimum qualification for appointment as an employee or for a particular position
or class of occupation in the Service.
32 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

18 Medical examination and retirement for medical reasons

(1) Before any person is appointed as an employee, that person must furnish
to the Commission at his own expense an up-to-date certificate or report on his
general state of health and fitness by a registered medical practitioner or medical
officer approved by the Commission.
(2) Every employee must if called upon, furnish to the Commission a
medical certificate or report on the employee’s general state of health and fitness
to continue in employment.
(3) If an employee has become inefficient or becomes unable to properly
perform the employee’s duties because of chronic or continuous illness, or change
in nature of a disability, the Commission may require the employee to retire from
the Service.
(4) An employee who provides to the Commission 2 independent medical
reports supporting that employee’s retirement for medical reasons may apply to
the Commission to retire as medically unfit for further duty, and the Commission
must grant such retirement if satisfied that the medical reports are valid.

19 Criteria for appointment

(1) All appointments shall be made on merit.
(2) The Commission must determine the merits of an applicant for
appointment to the Service by the applicant’s –
(a) Work experience and competence shown in the performance of
duties previously carried out in the Service or elsewhere; and
(b) Relevant educational and other qualifications; and,
(c) Personal qualities, characteristics and attributes relevant to the
position to be filled; and
(d) Any other factor specified by the Commission.
(3) The Commission may only appoint a person to a position in the Service,
who –
(a) Is available to take up the position within a reasonable time; and, (b) Has met at least the minimum qualifications criteria established
for the position.
(4) A member of the Commission who wishes to apply for a position in
the Service must not be a part of the interview panel.

20 Form of appointment

(1) The Commission may appoint an employee only –
(a) In the case of a permanent employee or a probationer, by issuing a
letter of appointment setting out the employee’s position and
capacity, and the salary and grade to which the employee has been
appointed;
(b) In the case of a contract employee, by entering into a contract with
specific terms and conditions;
(c) In the case of a temporary employee, by entering into a contract
with specific terms and conditions of employment.
(2) Except where express conditions of employment are provided in respect
of a contract employee or a temporary employee, the conditions of employment
shall be as provided in these Regulations and the Manual.

Constitution 33

21 Effective date of appointment and promotion

(1) The date of the document of appointment or promotion is the date the
appointment or promotion is effective unless the document of appointment or
promotion states otherwise.
(2) When a person is appointed or promoted to a position in the Service,
the salary in respect of that position is payable from the date on which the
appointment takes effect.

22 Appointment to specified offices

(1) Before appointing a person to a specified office, the Commission must,
in a manner that is consistent with its responsibilities under articles 68 and 69 of
the Constitution, consult the Minister to whom primary responsibility for the
department is allocated.
(2) Appointment to a specified office shall be for a term not exceeding 3
years and the appointment shall terminate at the end of the period specified in the
contract without further notice by the Commission.
(3) On the termination of appointment to a specified office, a permanent
employee shall, unless reappointed to that office or appointed to another specified
office, be transferred to another position in the Service on conditions no less
favourable than those that applied to the employee at the time of appointment to
the specified office.

23 Statutory declaration

Every employee must, on taking up employment in the Service, complete
a statutory declaration in a form approved by the Commission to the effect that
the attention of the employee has been drawn to the general conditions of
employment contained in these Regulations and the Manual, including specifically
regulations 4, 5, 11, 12 and 53.

24 Permanent employees

No person under the age of 18 years at the time of appointment shall be a
permanent employee.

25 Probation

(1) Subject to paragraphs (2) and (3), a person who is appointed to the
Service, other than as a contract or temporary employee, is on probation for a
period of not less than 3 months or more than 6 months, as the Commission
determines.
(2) The Commission may waive the probation period of an employee who
has previously been employed in the Service for 12 months or more.
(3) At the expiry of an employee’s period of probation, the Commission
may by notice in writing to a probationer –
(a) Extend the employee’s period of probation for a specified period
not exceeding 3 months; or
(b) Confirm or annul the employee’s appointment.
(4) Unless an earlier or later date is specified in the notice, the extension,
confirmation or annulment under paragraph (3) takes effect on and from the date
of the notice.
(5) If 30 days elapse following the period of probation and the Commission
has not taken action under paragraph (3), the appointment of that employee is
deemed to have been confirmed.
34 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

26 Contract employee

(1) The Commission may, in the best interest of the Service, enter into a
contract of service for a specific task or purpose for a specified period with any
person who is not a permanent employee of the Service.
(2) A contract entered into under paragraph (1) –
(a) Will be governed by its express terms and conditions and, to the
extent that they are not inconsistent with the contract, by these
Regulations as they apply to permanent employees; and,
(b) Shall be for a term not exceeding 3 years, but may be renewed or
extended for such period as considered necessary by the
Commission; and
(c) May be terminated at any time by the Commission on account of
serious misconduct by the employee.
(3) Where the appointment of the contract employee is to a specified office,
the appointment is subject to regulation 22.
(4) A contract employee who is subsequently appointed as a permanent
employee may apply to the Commission to have the period of contract employment
included as service as a permanent employee.

27 Temporary employee

(1) Temporary employees may be engaged and discharged as considered
necessary on terms and conditions of employment determined by the Commission.
(2) A temporary employee who is subsequently appointed as a permanent
employee may apply to the Commission to have the period of temporary
employment included as service as a permanent employee.

28 Cessation of employment

(1) Cessation of employment in the Service may occur by –
(a) In the case of a contract employee or a temporary employee, the
end of the term of the contract; or;
(b) By notice under this regulation; or,
(c) Retirement on medical grounds under regulation 18, by choice, or
under regulation 29(2); or,
(d) Forfeiture of office under regulation 69;
(e) Dismissal as the ultimate disciplinary measure; or
(f) Death.
(2) The employment of every permanent employee or contract employee
can be terminated by either party giving at least 3 months written notice.
(3) If a permanent employee gives the Commission less than 3 months
notice, the Commission may –
(a) Require a minimum of 3 months notice, or
(b) The Commission may accept a shorter period of notice, or
(c) May terminate the employment forthwith.
(4) The employment of a temporary employee may be terminated by either
party giving at least 2 weeks written notice.
(5) If a temporary employee gives the Commission less than 2 weeks notice,
the Commission may –
(a) Require a minimum of 2 weeks notice, or
(b) The Commission may accept a shorter period of notice, or
(c) May terminate the employment forthwith.

Constitution 35

29 Retirement from the Service

(1) A permanent employee who has completed not less than 10 years of
actual service may apply for retirement from the Service at 50 years of age.
(2) All permanent employees must retire at 55 years of age.

30 Re-employment

The Commission shall not employ as a permanent employee any person
who has been dismissed from the Service.
CANDIDACY AND MEMBERSHIP OF ASSEMBLY OR VILLAGE COUNCIL

31 Candidacy

(1) When an employee decides to become a candidate in the Assembly or
a Village Council election he must forthwith give notice in writing to his Head of
Department who must notify the Commission as soon as possible.
(2) An employee who becomes a candidate for election as a member of the
Assembly must be placed on leave of absence and the leave must commence no
later than nomination day and must continue until the day after polling day.
(3) During leave of absence under paragraph (2) the employee must –
(a) Not be required or permitted to carry out any official duties in the
Service; and
(b) Not be entitled to receive any salary or other remuneration as an
employee in respect of that period except to the extent to which
during that period any leave with pay to which the employee is
entitled is taken.
(4) Except as provided in paragraph (3) the rights and entitlements of the
candidate as an employee are not to be affected by the candidacy.

32 Membership of the Assembly or Village Council

(1) An employee who has become a candidate for election to the Assembly
or to a Village Council must, if the employee’s candidature is successful, give
notice in writing to the Commission through the Head of Department stating he
has been elected and declare whether he accepts the membership.
(2) An employee who has been granted leave of absence under article 18
of the Constitution must not, except with the Commission’s consent –
(a) Carry out any official duties in the Service; or
(b) Receive any salary or other remuneration as an employee for the
period of leave of absence other than leave with pay to which the
employee is entitled or for any official duties performed that have
been authorised by the Commission under this paragraph.
(3) Subject to paragraphs (1) and (2) the rights of a person as an employee
are not to be affected by membership of the Assembly or of a Village Council.
GRADING AND PROMOTION

33 Permanent positions to be graded

(1) The Commission must, to the extent that it considers practicable,
organise positions in the Service into occupational groups or classes.
(2) The Commission must divide each occupational group or class into
professional, technical, and support service grades.
(3) The Commission must place every employee, other than a contract
employee or temporary employee, in a suitable grade.
36 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

34 Determination and allocation of grades in the Service

(1) The Commission must allocate, and determine the date of application
(whether before, on, or after the date of the determination) of a grade and salary
to a position, having regard to –
(a) Any minimum qualifications required for the position;
(b) The level of responsibility the position entails;
(c) The experience and skill required for the position.
(2) There is no right of appeal against the Commission’s allocation of a
grade and its determination of the date of application of that grade for any position.
(3) The Commission must from time to time conduct a review of the grading
of the positions in Service and in so doing must ascertain whether or not there is
any need to adjust the salary scale or grading structure, having regard to the criteria
in paragraph (1).

35 Application for review of grading

(1) Notwithstanding regulation 33(3), a Head of Department may apply
to the Commission for a review of the grading of a position within the department.
(2) If the grade of the position has not been reviewed in the three years
immediately prior to the application, a permanent employee may apply in writing
to the Commission for a review of the grading for the position he occupies.
(3) On receipt of any application under paragraph (2) the Commission must
review the grade of the position in question and notify the employee of its decision.
(4) An employee who is not satisfied with the decision given under
paragraph (3) may, within 14 days after notification of the Commission’s decision,
apply to the Appeals Committee for a review of the application.

36 Performance assessment report on employees

(1) At least once every 12 months each Head of Department must provide
to the Commission in respect of each employee in the department, a performance
assessment report according to criteria determined by the Commission.
(2) At least once every 12 months the Commission must provide a
performance assessment report to Cabinet –
(a) In respect of the Secretary to the Government, after consultation
with the Premier; and
(b) In respect of Heads of Department, after consultation with the
appropriate Minister.

37 Advancement on merit

(1) The Commission may direct that an employee may not proceed beyond
a specific point in the salary range of the relevant grade, or it may approve
advancement if the Commission is satisfied that the employee’s assessed
performance warrants the advancement.
(2) The Commission may direct that an employee may not proceed beyond
a specific salary point until he has passed any qualifying examination or complied
with any professional standard that the Commission specifies.
(3) The Commission may accelerate the increase in salary of an employee
within the given grade for the position held by that employee, or it may instead
approve the payment to an employee of a special grant where –
(a) The employee has successfully completed a relevant course of
studies or achieved a professional standard which in the opinion of
the Commission is deserving of a special consideration; or
(b) In any other case of outstanding merit.

Constitution 37

GENERAL CONDITIONS OF EMPLOYMENT

38 List of employees

The Commission will publish annually a list of all employees, in such a
form and with such particulars as the Commission determines.

39 Allowances

The Commission may make provision in the Manual for the classes or types,
and the nature and rates of allowances employees may receive in addition to their
remuneration or, as additional terms and conditions of employment.

40 Hours of attendance

(1) The Commission must determine the hours of attendance to be observed
by all employees.
(2) The total ordinary time per week must not exceed 40 hours.

41 Additional hours of duty

(1) Any employee who is called upon by the head of department to work
additional hours must work such hours as required.
(2) Payment or time off in lieu for additional hours must be made at such
rates and conditions as the Commission determines.

42 Records of attendance

In every department attendance books or other records of attendance must
be kept, and in a form and with such particulars as determined by the Commission.

43 Absence from place of employment

No employee may leave the place of employment during the prescribed
hours of attendance, except on official business or with the permission of the
controlling officer.

44 Care of government stores and property

Every employee must exercise strict care and economy in the use of plant,
equipment, stores, stationery, documents and other property of the Government.

45 Accounts and government money

Every employee must exercise strict care in the handling of money held on
behalf of the Government, and in the observance of all instructions relating to
accounts and the collection, receipt, custody or payment of Government money.

46 Borrowing and lending of government money and property

No employee shall –
(a) Seek from another employee any unauthorised loan or allowance
from money held by that other employee as a receiver of public
money;
(b) Make any unauthorised loan or allowance out of money paid to or
held by the employee as a receiver of public money;
(c) Unlawfully authorise the expenditure, the use, or the lending of
public money, stores, equipment or other property of the
Government;
(d) Borrow any item of stores, equipment, plant or other Government
property for personal use.
38 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

47 Liability or commitment not to be incurred

No employee may, without proper authority, incur or attempt to incur any
liability or commitment, or make or vary or attempt to make or vary any contract
on behalf of the Government.

48 Secondary employment and participation in private business

(1) Every employee who expects to be appointed or to be elected to any
paid office in connection with any commercial or industrial or other business, or
to undertake any private practice of any profession or trade or be involved in the
management or work of any business whether or not owned by him, must first
apply in writing to the Commission for approval.
(2) Notwithstanding paragraph (1), an employee may engage in subsistence
agriculture, fishing or hunting activity outside working hours.
(3) Nothing in this regulation prohibits an employee from becoming a
member or shareholder of an incorporated body.

49 Service on statutory authorities

An employee must inform the Commission after accepting a nomination
or appointment as a judicial officer, a member of a statutory authority, board, or
committee (whether established by enactment or otherwise), or other Cabinet
nomination or appointment.

50 Conflict of interest

(1) If the employee becomes aware of any potential or actual conflict of
interest between the employee’s official duties, responsibilities and obligations
and the employee’s personal interest, whether directly or indirectly, the employee
must inform the Head of Department and the Head of Department must inform
the Commission accordingly.
(2) Examples of a conflict of interest include situations where –
(a) An individual or organisation with which an employee is involved
is given preferential treatment (whether by access to goods and
services or access to inside information) over any other individual
or organisation; or
(b) An employee has a financial or other interest or undertaking that
could directly or indirectly compromise the performance of the
employee’s duties, or the standing of the employee’s department
in its relationships with the public, clients, or Ministers.
(3) The Commission must take the necessary steps to emphasise to
employees their obligation to avoid, minimise or prevent involvement in any
situation where there will be a likely or actual conflict of interest.

51 Restrictions on remuneration

Except with the express approval of the Commission, no employee may
receive or accept otherwise than for the use of the Government, any gratuity, fee,
reward, refund or other remuneration of any kind whatsoever, except –
(a) The employee’s salary and any allowance owing to the employee
by the Government for services performed for the Government, or
for attendance in an official capacity or under a subpoena or order
to give evidence or produce documents in court;
(b) A refund for any necessary and reasonable expenses incurred and
paid for the employee in the performance of a service for the
Government or in attending at the court.

Constitution 39

52 Solicitation, acceptance of gifts or bribery

(1) No employee shall, directly or indirectly, solicit or accept gifts or
presents or gratuity or other valuable consideration from any person, either directly
or indirectly, in relation to any matter connected with the duties and responsibilities
of the employee.
(2) Nothing in this regulation prohibits the acceptance by an employee –
(a) Of a gift made as a token of courtesy according to local custom; or
(b) Of a gift presented to the employee on retirement from the Service
or on transfer from one locality to another; or
(c) Of a presentation from fellow employees.

53 Restriction on official information

(1) For the purpose of this regulation official information includes any
document, electronic storage device or instrument or item of equipment capable
of recording and or retaining information or data whether in writing, print,
graphics, film, voice, sound or in any other form.
(2) No employee shall use, remove or cause to be removed, copy by
whatever means or process, give to another person or party, damage or destroy,
or howsoever dispose of any official information unless it is specifically authorised.
(3) No employee shall use for any purpose, other than for the proper
discharge of his official duties any information gained by or conveyed to an
employee through his connection with the Service.
(4) No employee shall make any communication to the media or to any
person outside the Service –
(a) On matters affecting the Service, without the consent of the
Commission;
(b) On matters affecting the Government, without the consent of the
responsible Minister.

54 Outside influence

(1) No employee may solicit the influence of any person in order to obtain
an advantage on any matter concerning him, a friend or relative in the Service
whether it relates to promotion, transfer, discipline, investigation or any other
matter.
(2) Nothing in this regulation applies to evidence given on behalf of an
employee before a court, or the Appeals Committee, or to representations made
by the Service Organisation or to any application or representations made to the
Commission in accordance with these Regulations or the Manual, or to any request
by an employee for a certificate of employment, or a character reference intended
for a purpose outside of the Service.

55 Transfer and redeployment of employee

(1) The Commission may transfer any employee, and the employee so
directed must move accordingly and perform the duties assigned.
(2) Subject to the exigencies of the Service, the Commission shall give an
employee at least 1 week’s notice of its decision to transfer the employee.
(3) The conditions of employment of an employee transferred under
paragraph (1) shall be no less favourable than those that the transferred employee
was entitled to receive at the date of the transfer.
40 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(4) A transfer may be made –
(a) At the request of the employee; or
(b) Where the Commission decides that the transfer is in the interests
of departmental efficiency or desirable on the grounds of
administrative convenience; or
(c) Under regulation 76(3); or
(d) Under regulation 75(1)(c).
(5) In consultation with the Commission, the Cabinet or the Minister
responsible may redeploy an employee by releasing that employee for a specified
period and on agreed terms and conditions, to be engaged on an approved
community project, or other work outside of the Service, provided the principal
duties and responsibilities of the employee will not be adversely affected.
(6) Any decision as to transfer by the Commission shall be final and not
subject to appeal or judicial review.

56 Rent for accommodation

Where the government provides an employee with accommodation, any
rent payable in respect of that accommodation may be deducted from the
employee’s remuneration or from any other money due to the employee without
further authority other than this regulation.

57 Authority to take money for unpaid debt to the Government

If an employee owes a debt to the Government which has been outstanding
for at least 6 months, and the employee acknowledges in writing to the Commission
that he owes the debt, then the Commission may authorise the deduction of a
reasonable amount from the employee’s fortnightly salary, not exceeding 10% of
the employee’s net after tax salary.

58 Annual leave

LEAVE
direct.
Every employee must be granted annual leave as the Commission may

59 Special leave

In special cases the Commission may grant special leave of absence with or
without pay on such terms and conditions as the Commission may determine.

60 Maternity leave

(1) Female employees may be granted maternity leave for such periods
and subject to such conditions as the Commission determines, provided the
employee has been in the Service for not less than 12 months immediately prior to
application for maternity leave.
(2) Where a female employee has been granted maternity leave, that
employee may receive up to 60 consecutive days leave on full pay, and a further
30 consecutive days on 50% pay, at current salary, payable fortnightly from the
commencement of the maternity leave period.
(3) The Commission may, upon application, approve a period of up to 6
months at any one time of maternity leave to be counted towards continuous
service and contributory service.

Constitution 41

61 Paternity leave

A male employee may be granted 5 consecutive days paternity leave with
pay in the event of the birth of his child.

62 Contract and temporary employee leave

(1) Leave of any kind for a contract employee is either stipulated in the
contract document or, if not so stipulated, is the same as for permanent employees.
(2) If not otherwise determined by the Commission, leave of any kind for
a temporary employee shall be the same as for permanent employees.

63 Retiring leave

Every employee who qualifies under criteria established by the Commission
shall be entitled to retiring leave based on the length of the employee’s service,
and on terms and conditions determined by the Commission.

64 Payment for leave on death of employee

On the death of an employee the Commission may approve payment to
the surviving spouse or dependants of the estate of any amount equal to the salary
or wages that could have been granted to the deceased for any annual leave,
retiring, and other leave due if he or she had retired on the date of death.

65 Sick leave

(1) Every employee must be granted sick leave on account of sickness or
accident for such periods as determined by the Commission.
(2) No employee shall absent himself from duty under a false plea of
sickness or accident.

66 Long service leave

Long service leave may be available for such class or classes of employee
on such terms and conditions as are determined by the Commission.

67 Bereavement leave

(1) Employees shall be granted 5 days bereavement leave for immediate
family members.
(2) In this regulation, “immediate family” means the spouse, child, mother,
father, brother or sister.

68 Public holidays

(1) Holidays prescribed by any enactment must be observed in the Service.
(2) Cabinet may declare additional holidays to be observed by members
of the Service as “Public Service Holidays”.

69 Forfeiture of employment

(1) An employee who is absent from duty, or who fails to return to duty,
and in either case continues to be absent without permission for a period of 4
weeks or more, forfeits office.
(2) Notice of the effect of this regulation must during such absence, but
not sooner than 14 days after the first day of such absence, be sent to the employee
by letter or facsimile to the employee’s usual or last known place of abode. An
employee who returns to duty before the expiration of the week beginning with
the day after the date on which notice is so sent or the expiration of 4 weeks absence
from duty, whichever is the later, does not forfeit office under paragraph (1).
42 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(3) If the employee subsequently satisfies the Commission that there was a valid reason for the absence and for the failure to inform the Commission earlier of that reason, the Commission may reinstate the employee and in such case the employee will be deemed not to have forfeited office, but to have been on leave from the Service during the period of absence.
DISCIPLINARY PROVISIONS

70 Compliance with instructions and employee complaints

(1) Every employee must carry out all lawful instructions given by the
controlling officer.
(2) An employee who considers there is ground for complaint arising out
of an instruction given in the Service, or harassment, or threatening behaviour
from another employee or from any other cause, may report the matter to the
Head of Department or to the Commission.

71 Unsatisfactory performance

Where it is found that the work or conduct of an employee is unsatisfactory
but not of such nature as to warrant the taking of disciplinary proceedings before
the Commission, the Head of Department or the controlling officer must draw the
attention of the employee to his shortcomings and a record of the action taken
must be made and copied to the Commission.

72 Allegations for disciplinary action

(1) Where the Head of Department believes that the work, conduct,
behaviour or attitude of an employee is such that disciplinary proceedings should
be instituted the Head of Department must report the matter to the Commission,
and the report must include all necessary factual evidence.
(2) Where the Commission is in receipt of a substantiated complaint or
report from another employee or member of the public, the Commission must
request the department for a report on the matter before deciding whether to pursue
disciplinary proceedings.

73 Disciplinary proceedings

(1) Disciplinary proceedings must be instituted if the Commission is
satisfied that sufficient evidence exists to act under regulation 72.
(2) Disciplinary proceedings must commence with the Commission serving
the employee with written notice of the complaint, stating whether by act or
omission the employee has –
(a) Behaved in an improper manner in carrying out official duties; or
(b) Behaved in a manner that has affected or is likely to adversely affect
the performance of his duties; or
(c) Behaved in a manner that has brought or is likely to bring the Service
into disrepute; or
(d) Failed to comply with these Regulations.
(3) The employee must reply to the Commission in writing within a
reasonable time to be specified in the notice, stating –
(a) Whether the truth of the complaint is admitted or denied; and,
(b) Any further explanation that the employee wishes to make in respect
to the complaint.
(4) If the employee does not deny the truth of the complaint or decides not
to reply to the notice within the time specified, the employee is deemed to have
admitted the truth of the complaint.

Constitution 43

(5) The Commission must then proceed to consider and determine the matter taking into account any reply, together with the report by the department and such other reports as may have been obtained that are relevant.
(6) If, after the expiry of the time specified, and the employee has in writing denied the truth of the complaint, the Commission decides that the complaint should be investigated it may appoint a person or persons specifically for that purpose, and that person or persons must hold an inquiry into the complaint.
(7) The person or persons appointed under paragraph (6) may summon and examine on oath any person, including the employee, whose evidence may be necessary or material.
(8) The employee in respect of whom the complaint is made is entitled to be present at all times during the enquiry and may be represented by counsel or an agent or the Service Organisation and shall be entitled either personally or through an adviser to make representations, call evidence (including giving evidence personally), and cross-examine other witnesses who give evidence, in respect of the complaint.
(9) After holding the inquiry, the person or persons appointed under paragraph (6) must report to the Commission on whether or not the inquiry is of the opinion the complaint is true or untrue, and must also forward to the Commission a copy of all evidence taken at the enquiry.
(10) If the truth of the complaint is admitted by the employee, or if the
Commission after consideration of the reports relating to the complaint and any
reply or explanation furnished by the employee and the department, and after
such further investigation or inquiry (if any) as is considered necessary, is satisfied
as to the truth of the complaint, the Commission may, after taking into account
the service record of the employee, impose one or more of the penalties contained
in regulation 75.
(11) If, in respect of any complaint made against an employee, the
Commission does not find the complaint against the employee established, the
employee must be declared to be not guilty and must be notified by the
Commission in writing accordingly.
(12) The Commission must within 14 days of deciding any complaint against
an employee under this regulation, notify the employee in writing of the decision.
(13) The procedure for dealing with a disciplinary matter in the case of a
Head of Department is the same as for other employees.
(14) In the case of a disciplinary matter concerning the Secretary to the
Government the Commission, using the same procedures, may institute
disciplinary proceedings either at the request of the Premier, or at its own initiative.

74 Conviction for offence

(1) An employee who has been convicted of a criminal offence in Niue or
elsewhere must notify his Head of Department who must in turn notify the
Commission.
(2) In determining whether disciplinary proceedings should apply to an
employee convicted of an offence, the Commission must take into account the
nature and seriousness of the criminal offence and the penalty imposed by the
court.
44 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

75 Penalties

(1) Subject to paragraph (2), if an employee is convicted of an offence, or if
the Commission is satisfied of the truth of the allegations made in a notice under
regulation 73 against an employee, the Commission may –
(a) Dismiss the employee without notice forthwith; or
(b) Dismiss the employee with notice; or
(c) Assign the employee to other duties; or
(d) Reduce the salary of the employee; or
(e) Reprimand and warn the employee; or
(f) Put the employee on probation for a specified period.
(2) The Commission may impose one or a combination of more than one
of the above penalties, but where an employee is dismissed, the Commission may
not impose additional penalties.

76 Suspension

(1) An employee who for the time being is considered by the Head of
Department to be unfit to perform his duties properly shall be suspended from
duty by the Commission until the employee is, in the opinion of the Head of
Department and the Commission again capable of performing his duties effectively.
(2) An employee who has been charged with a criminal offence punishable
by imprisonment for a term of one year or more, must be suspended from duty by
the Commission until the matter has been determined.
(3) An employee who has been served with a notice of complaint under
regulation 73 may be transferred to another position or be suspended from duty
by the Commission pending the determination of the complaint.
(4) The Commission may at any time revoke any suspension made under
this regulation if the circumstances warrant.
(5) Suspension under this regulation may be with or without pay as the
Commission determines.
(6) Unless the Commission otherwise directs, an employee who has been
suspended under paragraph (2) without pay and is subsequently found not guilty
of the offence, whether it is criminal or a disciplinary proceeding to which the
suspension relates or the allegations against the employee are not proved, must
be paid any loss of earnings suffered while so suspended.

77 Incriminating questions

(1) No employee may refuse to answer a question properly asked under
these Regulations solely on the grounds that it could lead to disciplinary
proceedings being taken against himself or another employee.
(2) An employee who refuses to answer incriminating questions is entitled,
before answering any questions, to consult a lawyer, or a Service Organisation
representative, or any other person.
APPEALS

78 Right of appeal of permanent employee

(1) Only permanent employees have a right of appeal and an appeal may
be made –
(a) Against any determination of the Commission to appoint any person other than an employee or to promote any employee to a position on the permanent staff with a higher salary grade than that of the appellant;

Constitution 45

(b) Against a decision of the Commission made under regulations 72 and 73 that a complaint is established;
(c) Against a review of grading under regulation 35(4).
(2) The Appeals Committee shall hear all appeals made under these
Regulations.

79 Situation where no appeal lies

Notwithstanding regulation 78 no appeal may lie against any determination
of the Commission –
(a) Transferring an employee from one position to another at his
existing salary and grade pursuant to regulations 16 and 55; or
(b) Appointing a person to a position for which the intended appellant
himself had not applied; or
(c) Appointing a person as a contract or temporary employee; or
(d) In respect of the position of the Secretary to the Government.

80 Appeals Committee

(1) The Public Service Appeals Committee established under the Niue
Public Service Regulations 1979 is continued in accordance with these Regulations.
(2) The Appeals Committee must consist of –
(a) A Chairperson to be appointed by Cabinet;
(b) An employee or retired employee appointed as official member by
the Commission;
(c) An employee appointed by the Commission on the nomination of
the Service Organisation.
(3) No member shall act on the Appeals Committee in any appeal affecting
an employee of the department in which the member is an employee, or in any
appeal affecting himself, a friend, a relative or associate.
(4) Public notice shall be given of every appointment to the Appeals
Committee.
(5) Each member is to be paid such remuneration as the Cabinet determines
on the recommendation of the Commission.

81 Appeals Committee procedures

(1) A person who wishes to appeal a determination of the Commission
may lodge a notice of appeal with the Commission within 14 days after the
Commission’s determination has been made known.
(2) The Commission must, within 7 days of its receipt, forward to the
Chairperson of the Appeals Committee a notice of appeal lodged in accordance
with these Regulations.
(3) The Appeals Committee must sit at such place and at such time as
determined by its Chairperson.
(4) The Appeals Committee must determine its own procedures and may
receive such evidence in such manner as it thinks fit, whether or not that evidence
would be admissible in a court of law.
(5) After it has considered an appeal, the Appeals Committee must convey
in writing to the Commission its findings stating –
(a) Whether the appeal should be allowed or disallowed; and,
(b) Whether, in the case of an application for a review of grading, the
grading of the applicant should be adjusted or not.
(6) The Appeals Committee may add to its findings any recommendation
or comment it thinks appropriate.
46 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(7) If any appeal is, in the opinion of the Appeals Committee, frivolous or vexatious, the Committee shall dismiss the appeal and may in any such case require the appellant to pay to the Government all or such part as the Committee may specify, of the costs of the appeal.

82 Appeal decision

(1) The Commission must notify the appellant of the findings and
recommendations of the Appeals Committee together with the decision of the
Commission on the findings.
(2) The Commission’s decision on the appeal is final.
TRANSITIONAL AND REPEAL PROVISIONS

83 Transitional provision

The transition from the Niue Public Service Regulations 1979 to the Niue
Public Service Regulations 2004 is provided for in the Schedule.
––––––––––––

SCHEDULE (Regulation 83) TRANSITIONAL PROVISIONS

1 These Regulations take the place of the Niue Public Service Regulations 1979. They provide for the management, work conditions and employment rules of the Service in accordance with the Constitution.

2 (1) All employees appointed after the commencement of these Regulations shall be governed by these Regulations.

(2) Employees appointed before the commencement of these Regulations shall be governed by these Regulations unless otherwise specified in this Schedule, but in no case on terms less favourable than those that applied to them immediately before the commencement of these Regulations.

3 (1) Employees in specified offices at the commencement of these Regulations shall continue in their current office on the terms and conditions agreed under the revoked Regulations that applied to them immediately before the commencement of these Regulations.

(2) If the term of appointment to a specified office was for an agreed period of time, the holding of that office shall terminate at the time then agreed.

(3) On the termination of the period under paragraph (2) the Commission shall, if the office remains an office of the Service, advertise the vacancy, or reappoint the employee to the office.

(4) The employee whose term has expired and who has not been reappointed may apply for the vacancy and may, in accordance with these Regulations, be reappointed to it by the Commission.

(5) The employee whose term has expired and who has not applied or not been reappointed shall –

(a) Continue in the Service under these Regulations, and

(b) In such office as the Commission directs, and

(c) On conditions not less favourable than those that applied to the employee

in the exercise of the specified office.

(6) An employee whose term in a specified office has expired shall, if the office

ceases to be an office in the Service shall –

Constitution 47

(a) Continue in the Service under these Regulations, (b) In such office as the Commission directs, and

(c) On conditions not less favourable than those that applied to the employee in the exercise of the specified office.

4 Any disciplinary proceedings commenced before the entry into force of these

Regulations shall continue in accordance with the requirements of the revoked Regulations.

5 (1) Any disciplinary proceeding commenced after the entry into force of these

Regulations shall be conducted in accordance with these Regulations.

(2) If the proceedings relate to a matter or incident that occurred before the

commencement of these Regulations the proceedings shall be conducted under these

Regulations but no greater penalty shall be imposed on the employee than that which

could have been imposed under the revoked Regulations.

––––––––––––

48 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

49

AGRICULTURE QUARANTINE

ANIMAL QUARANTINE (DISEASE CONTROL) REGULATIONS 1991

1991/2 – 1 September 1991

1

2

3

4

5

Title

Interpretation

Powers of authorised officers

Eradication of endemic diseases or pests

Preventing foreign disease outbreaks

6

7

Dealing with endemic or foreign diseases or pests

Offences and penalties

1 Title

These are the Animal Quarantine (Disease Control) Regulations 1991.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these regulations –
“authorised officer” means a Quarantine Officer, Livestock Officer or other
person authorised by the Director of Agriculture to act under these
Regulations;
“Director” means the Director of Agriculture;
“endemic disease or pest” means an animal disease or pest which is known
to be present in Niue;
“foreign disease or pest” means an animal disease or pest which is not
known to be present in Niue;
“Minister” means the Minister of Agriculture.
(2) Terms and expressions defined in the Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984
shall, when used in these Regulations, have the meanings so defined unless the
context otherwise requires.

3 Powers of authorised officers

An authorised officer may –
(a) Direct that the owner or person-in-charge of any animal gather and
restrain the animal for the purpose of examination, testing,
medication, vaccination or other measure which is considered
necessary for the diagnosis of disease or pests or the prevention of
the occurrence or the spread of disease or pests;
(b) Apply to an animal any diagnostic tests for disease or take tissue or
other specimens from an animal for the purpose of diagnostic tests;
(c) Kill any animal which is diseased or suspect to be diseased for the
purpose of conducting an autopsy or obtaining specimens for
diagnostic purposes;
(d) Direct that an animal or animal product which is diseased or is
suspected of being diseased or infected be isolated from other
animals or animal products or one from the other;
50 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(e) Direct that any herd or flock of animals suspected of being diseased or infected by pests, be placed in quarantine;
(f) Direct that any land that contains or has contained any animal suspected of being diseased or infected, or pests, be placed in quarantine;
(g) Direct that any animal or herd or flock of animals be medicated,
vaccinated, managed or otherwise dealt with in order to prevent
the occurrence of or to eradicate or control, or to minimise the spread
of any disease or pest;
(h) Direct that any land, premises or conveyance be cleaned, disinfected
or treated in a specified way.

4 Eradication of endemic diseases or pests

Where the Director with the approval of the Minister is of the opinion that
a disease or pest already present in Niue should be controlled or eradicated, the
Director may cause –
(a) The owner or person-in-charge of any animals to gather together
those animals as often as may be specified and restrain them in
suitable facilities so that an authorised officer can examine, identify,
medicate, vaccinate, and sample the animals or subject them to
diagnostic tests;
(b) Any animal which is found to be diseased or infected or affected
by pests to be medicated or destroyed or otherwise disposed of;
(c) Any land, premises or goods exposed to diseased or infected
animals or harbouring pests to be treated or disposed of in a
specified manner.

5 Preventing foreign disease outbreaks

If it seems to the Minister likely that a foreign animal disease or pest has
been or may be introduced into Niue, the Minister may –
(a) Impose prohibitions or restrictions on the movement of animals,
animal products, fodder, fittings and other things as may be
specified, into, out of, or within any part of or the whole of Niue;
(b) Cause animals of a designated type to be medicated, vaccinated
restrained, fed or otherwise managed in a specified manner;
(c) Cause land, premises, conveyances or other thing to be destocked,
cleaned, disinfected or otherwise treated or their use prohibited
totally.

6 Dealing with endemic or foreign diseases or pests

(1) If an authorised officer has reasonable cause to believe that any animals
on any land or in any premises are diseased or infected or affected by pests he
may quarantine that land by issuing an Infected Place Notice to the owner or
person-in-charge of the land.
(2) Whilst any land is subject to an Infected Place Notice, no animal, animal
product, animal excreta, fodder, fittings or other thing as may be specified in the
notice may be moved off that land without the permission of an authorised person
and subject to conditions which he may specify.
(3) An authorised officer may medicate, vaccinate or destroy any diseased
or infected animal; and order the cleaning, disinfection or other treatment of
premises, conveyances or other things in an infected place.

Agriculture Quarantine 51

(4) Subsequent to an infected place being declared, the Director may declare a disease control area including that infected place and comprising part or the whole of Niue.
(5) Whilst a disease control area is in effect, no animal, animal product, fodder, fitting or other thing as may be specified in the declaration may be moved out of, into or within the disease control area without the permission of an authorised person and subject to such conditions as may be imposed.
(6) Any wild or feral animal the presence of which is or may be detrimental to the effective control of an animal disease or pest may be eliminated by authority of the Director acting with the approval of the Minister.

7 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person commits an offence who acts in contravention of any of
these regulations, or who fails to observe a reasonable direction of the Minister of
Agriculture, Director or other authorised officer under these regulations.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against these regulations is liable
upon conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or to a term of imprisonment
not exceeding 12 months, or to both such fine and imprisonment.
52 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

ANIMAL QUARANTINE (FEES) REGULATIONS 1991

1991/3 – 1 September 1991

1 Title

These are the Animal Quarantine (Fees) Regulations 1991.

2 Fees

There shall be payable in respect of the matters set out in the First Column
of the Schedule, the fees set out opposite those matters in the Second Column of
the Schedule.
–––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE Application to import animal or

semen or ova of an animal $10.00

Grant of permit to import animal or

semen or ova of an animal $10.00

Application for permit to import animal

products $10.00

Grant of permit to import biological

products or organisms $10.00

AGRICULTURAL QUARANTINE PHYTOSANITARY CERTIFICATE (FEES) REGULATIONS 1993

1993/1 – 1 July 1997

1 Title

These are the Agricultural Quarantine Phytosanitary Certificates (Fees)
Regulations 1993.

2 Fees

There shall be payable in respect of the matters set out in the First Column
of the Schedule the fees set out opposite those matters in the Second Column of
the Schedule.
–––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

Phytosanitary certificate for one package $6.00

Inspection charges for each additional

package in excess of one $1.00 for each package

––––––––––––––––––––

Agriculture Quarantine 53

AGRICULTURE QUARANTINE (PREVENTION OF ANIMAL DISEASE) REGULATIONS 1991

1991/4 – 1 September 1991

1

Short title

9

Further action may be directed

2

Interpretation

10

Disposal of garbage

3

Importation of animals

11

Stores not to be introduced

4

Importation of certain animals prohibited

12

Disinfection

5

Importation of animal products, biological

13

Feeding of pigs and poultry

products and organisms

14

Management of rubbish dumps

6

Importation of vehicles

15

No liability to Crown

7

Introduction of fodder, crates

16

Offences and penalties

8

Introduction of animal excreta

1 Title

These are the Agriculture Quarantine (Prevention of Animal Disease)
Regulations 1991.

2 Interpretation

Terms and expressions defined in the Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984 shall,
when used in these regulations, have the meanings so defined unless the context
otherwise requires.

3 Importation of animals

(1) No animal, or semen or ova of an animal shall be imported into Niue,
except pursuant to and in accordance with the terms and conditions of a permit
issued by or under the authority of the Director.
(2) Every person wishing to import an animal or semen or ova of an animal
shall apply in writing to the director for a permit to import such animal semen or
ova, such application to be in such form as may from time to time be required by
the Director.
(3) The Director may approve or refuse any application made under
paragraph (2), or may approve such application subject to such conditions as the
Director thinks fit to impose.
(4) Without limiting the generality of the Director ’s discretion to impose
conditions under paragraph (3), such condition may include conditions relating
to –
(a) Origin and general health;
(b) Diagnostic tests, medication or vaccinations;
(c) Periods of, or type of quarantine to be observed in the country of
origin, or in transit to or within Niue;
(d) Such post-entry conditions as the Director thinks fit in relation to
quarantine (location and period) diagnostic tests, medication and
vaccinations as the Director may require.
(e) Such other requirements as in the opinion of the Director are
necessary to prevent the introduction of animal diseases or pests.
(5) Every person who imports an animal, or semen or ova of an animal
otherwise than under the requirements of this section commits an offence and
shall on conviction be liable to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units.
54 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(6) Upon a conviction being entered under paragraph (5), the Court may, in addition to any other penalty, order the animal, semen or ova as the case may be, to be re-shipped to the country of origin or destroyed or otherwise disposed of at the expense of the importer as the Court may specify.
(7) Notwithstanding any other provision of this clause, the Director may at any time order the re-shipment destruction or disposal of any animal, semen or ova of an animal which has been imported into Niue where the Director is of the opinion that notwithstanding any quarantine, vaccination or other precaution that may have been taken, the animal, semen or ova is likely to introduce disease into Niue.

4 Importation of certain animals prohibited

Notwithstanding any other provisions of these Regulations, the Director
shall not issue a permit for the import of any animal, or semen, or ova of an animal
which in the opinion of the Director is venomous, environmentally damaging, or
is or is likely to be a nuisance in Niue.

5 Importation of animal products, biological products and organisms

(1) No animal product, biological product, or organism shall be imported
into Niue except pursuant to and in accordance with the terms and conditions of
a permit issued by or under the authority of the Director.
(2) Every person wishing to import an animal product, biological product
or organism shall apply in writing to the director for a permit such animal product,
biological product or organism, such application to be in such form as may be
required by the Director.
(3) The Director may approve or refuse any application made under
paragraph (2), or may approve such application subject to such conditions as the
Director thinks fit to impose.
(4) Without limiting the generality of the Director ’s discretion to impose
conditions under paragraph (3), such conditions may include conditions relating
to –
(a) Origin and general health;
(b) Diagnostic tests, treatment and storage (including packaging);
(c) Periods of, or type of quarantine to be observed in the country of
origin, or in transit to or within Niue;
(d) Such post-entry conditions as the Director thinks fit in relation to
diagnostic tests, packing, and quarantine (location and period) as
the Director may require;
(e) Such other requirements as in the opinion of the Director are
necessary to prevent the introduction of animal diseases or pests.

6 Importation of vehicles

(1) No vehicle, farm implement or equipment, goods or chattels of any
kind which have been on a farm or used in connection with animals or animal
products shall be imported into Niue unless –
(a) Properly cleaned in the country of origin; and
(b) Accompanied on arrival in Niue by a certificate of treatment in a
form approved by the Director which indicates to the satisfaction
of the Director that the goods have been so cleaned.
(2) Notwithstanding paragraph (1), the Director may require any goods to
which this section applies, to be cleaned prior to release in Niue where the Director
is of the opinion that the goods have not been properly cleaned prior to arrival.

Agriculture Quarantine 55

7 Introduction of fodder, crates

(1) No animal fodder, crate, harness, bedding or goods of any kind which
have accompanied or been used or have come into contact with any animal product,
biological product or organism shall be imported into Niue except with the
approval of the Director, and under the terms and conditions imposed by the
Director.
(2) In granting any approval under paragraph (1), the Director may impose
such terms and conditions as the Director thinks fit, including terms and conditions
relating to the treatment, disinfection, destruction or other disposal of the goods.

8 Introduction of animal excreta

(1) No animal excreta, urine or other secretion, hair or other tissue shall be
imported into Niue except with the approval of the Director, and under the terms
and conditions imposed by the Director.
(2) In granting any approval under paragraph (1), the Director may impose
such terms and conditions as the Director thinks fit, including terms and conditions
relating to the treatment, disinfection, destruction or other disposal of the goods.

9 Further action may be directed

Notwithstanding any other of these Regulations, the Director may on the
importation of any animal or any time thereafter, require any examination,
diagnostic testing, medication, vaccination or other action in respect of the imported
animal or its progeny, or its destruction; or any treatment, fumigation or sterilisation
of any animal product or biological product or organism, or its destruction; or
any cleaning, disinfection or other treatment of any equipment, vehicles,
conveyances, fittings, clothing, goods or other things that have been or may have
been in direct or indirect contact with any animal, or their destruction, if in the
opinion of the Director there are reasonable grounds for doing so for the purpose
of preventing the introduction of disease or pests into Niue.

10 Disposal of garbage

(1) No person shall permit any refuse or garbage, or material which has
been in contact with refuse or garbage, to be unloaded from a ship, aircraft or
other conveyance arriving in Niue from any other country unless such refuse
garbage or material is handled, incinerated and treated, or otherwise disposed of
in a manner or approved by the Director, acting in consultation with the Director
of Health.
(2) The cost of handling, incineration treatment or other disposal under
paragraph (1), may be recovered from the owner, operator, charterer, or agent of
any such person, of the ship or aircraft.
(3) Except as provided in paragraph (1), no refuse, garbage or rubbish from
any conveyance shall be disposed of in the territorial waters of Niue.

11 Stores not to be introduced

(1) No person shall –
(a) Introduce or permit to be introduced into Niue, meat and eggs or
other food containing material of animal origin that constitute food
provisions of ships, aircraft or other conveyances; or
(b) Use or permit to be used such meat, eggs or other food as aforesaid
as bait for fishing; or
(c) Dispose or permit to be disposed of such meat eggs or other food
into the territorial waters of Niue.
56 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(2) The Director may require that the lockers or food stores of a ship or aircraft be sealed whilst on Niue or within Niuean territorial limits, to ensure compliance with paragraph (1).

12 Disinfection

(1) The Director may require any ship, aircraft or other conveyance arriving
in Niue to be treated, cleaned or disinfected or disinfected or fumigated as the
Director considers necessary to prevent the possible introduction of disease or
pests.
(2) The cost of the treatment, cleaning, disinfection, disinsection or fumigation may be recovered from the owner, operator, charterer, or agent of the conveyance as a debt due to the Crown.

13 Feeding of pigs and poultry

(1) The Director may prescribe measures for the management and control
of pigs and poultry, including containment, feeding, medication, vaccination or
other measures which the Director considers necessary to prevent the introduction
or spread of disease, parasites or pests.
(2) The Director may require that before feeding to pigs or poultry all
garbage, kitchen scraps, waste food and the like, or other food containing or
consisting of meat or fish or other animal products, from hotels, motels, hospitals,
prisons, restaurants, food bars, and like sources be heat treated to the extent
prescribed, or otherwise treated in a manner approved by the Director as the
Director considers necessary to prevent the introduction or spread of disease or
parasites.

14 Management of rubbish dumps

The Director may require the owner, occupier or user of a rubbish dump to
ensure that the rubbish dump is covered regularly or fenced off or otherwise
managed in such a way as to minimise pigs, poultry or dogs gaining access to
refuse or rubbish which contains meat, or other animal products or animal carcases.

15 No liability to Crown

(1) No cost to an owner, operator, charterer or agent in carrying out any
requirement of these Regulations shall be recoverable from the Crown.
(2) If any owner, operator, charterer or agent fails to carry out any
requirement of these Regulations the Director or a Quarantine Officer may arrange
for the necessary work to be done and recover the cost from the owner, operator,
charterer or agent as a debt due to the Crown.

16 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person who fails to comply with or acts in contravention of any
provision of these Regulations commits an offence.
(2) Every person who fails to obey a direction given by the Director, a
Quarantine Officer or other authorised officer or his assistant under these
Regulations, or who fails to provide truthfully and fully any information pertinent
to these Regulations required of him by the Director or a Quarantine Officer,
commits an offence.
(3) Every person who commits an offence against any of these Regulations
is liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 5 penalty units or a term of
imprisonment not exceeding 12 months, or to both such fine and imprisonment.

Agriculture Quarantine 57

PLANT QUARANTINE REGULATIONS 1985

1985 – 1 January 1986

1 Title

2 Interpretation

PART 1

20 Entry of fruits and vegetables

21 Entry of timber

22 Entry of cut and dried flowers

23 Entry of plant material not capable of

GENERAL REQUIREMENTS

3 Points of entry

4 Inspection of plant or non-plant material

5 Requirements of all persons entering Niue

in possession of plant material and

regulated material

6 Placement in quarantine

7 Treatment

8 Release of plants, plant material or goods

9 Transport, storage, unpacking treatment

10 Seizure and destruction

11 Disposal of plant material

12 Inspection and treatment of conveyances

13 Applications for permits

14 Plant quarantine forms

15 Official introduction by Government

16 Permit to land

17 Quarantine for live plants

PART 2

ENTRY OF PLANTS, PLANT MATERIAL, PESTS, GOODS

18 Entry of plant material capable of growth

19 Entry of seed

growth

24 Entry of soil

25 Entry of non-plant articles

26 Vessels from areas where rhinoceros beetle

occurs

27 Entry of pests or cultures

28 Entry of tissue culture of plants

29 Entry of honey bees

30 Entry of material for research purposes

31 Entry of packing material, used or second

hand bags and dunnage

32 Entry of handicrafts made from plant

material

33 Exclusion of liability

PART 3

GENERAL PROVISIONS

34 Specific prohibitions and restrictions

35 Emergency powers

36 Export requirements

37 Fees

SCHEDULE

1 Title

These are the Plant Quarantine Regulations 1985.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Agriculture Quarantine Act 1985;
“as prescribed” means any procedure or treatment as detailed by the
Director or contained in a manual or official treatment schedule
approved by the Director;
“baggage” means any goods brought into the country by a passenger
arriving by sea or by air from overseas;
“contamination” means any infection or infestation by plant disease or pest
or having an association with unauthorised plant material or soil;
“conveyance” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“Declaration” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“Director” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“disease” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“dunnage” means timber, usually low grade, used for stowing goods in
conveyances such as vessels or cargo containers;
“first point of entry” means the designated location through which plants,
plant material and other regulated goods may enter the country from
overseas;
58 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
“fruit” means the edible product of any plant whether attached to the plant or not and includes any peel, skin, shell or seeds, whether edible or not, as well as vegetables;
“goods” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act; “import” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act; “infected” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act; “land” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“noxious weed” means a plant declared by Cabinet to be harmful and subject to quarantine control;
“owner” means the person, corporate body or organisation, responsible for plants, plant material, pests, diseases, goods or soil, because he, she or it is the owner or the owner ’s agent or the person to whom these are consigned, or by whom they are being exported or the person, corporate body or organisation in charge of the conveyance in which plants, plant material, goods, pests, diseases or soil are being carried or have been carried;
“permit” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act; “pest” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act; “plant” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“plant material” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“phytosanitary certificate” means an official certificate issued by an
authorised quarantine officer, substantially in the format of the Model
Certificate of the International Plant Protection convention, attesting
that the plant, to which it refers, has been inspected and found free
from quarantine pests and substantially free from other injurious pests;
“quarantine area” means any land where a specified adjoining land by the
Cabinet to be a quarantine area (for a prescribed period of time);
“quarantine pest or disease” means a pest or disease of potential national
economic importance to the country endangered thereby and not yet
presented there or present but not widely distributed and being actively
controlled;
“quarantine officer” means any officer appointed under section 4 of the
Act and includes an assistant;
“packing material” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“refuse” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“regulated material” means such plants, plant material, garbage, soil and
other items that come within the provision of the Act;
“re-export” means to remove or ship plant material from Niue as a means
of removing the pest and disease risk;
“soil” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act;
“timber” means logs, poles, dunnage, branchwood, firewood, bark and all
wood which has been split, hewn, sawn or dressed but not otherwise
manufactured and includes pre-fabricated building units, shakes,
shingles, and wooden cases or boxes;
“treatment” has the same meaning as in section 2 of the Act.

3 Points of entry

PART 1
GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
No plant material or other regulated material may be imported into Niue except through the port of Alofi, the Hanan International Airport, the Post Office at Alofi, or such other places as may be notified by the Cabinet.

Agriculture Quarantine 59

4 Inspection of plant or non-plant material

(1) All plant material, all fruit and vegetables or any other plant or any
goods the entry of which presents a risk of pest or disease to Niue in the opinion
of the quarantine officer and if necessary, shall be subject to treatments for the
prevention of entry of disease or pest or if necessary, shall be subject to destruction
or re-exported to the country of origin as the case may be.
(2) All treatments are performed at the risk of the importer or his agent.
(3) Any goods include all passenger ’s baggage, personal effects and
clothing as well as vehicles, containers, drums and anything liable to carry a pest
or disease of plants.

5 Requirements of all persons entering Niue in possession of plant material and regulated material

(1) Every person arriving from overseas shall be required to make a declaration in respect of plants, plant material, soil, culture or any other thing the subject of these Regulations.
(2) No person shall introduce into Niue any plant, plant material, or any other thing the subject of these Regulations unless these Regulations have been duly complied with in respect of plant material or other regulated material.

6 Placement in quarantine

Where a quarantine officer is not satisfied that the imported plants, plant
material or goods are free of diseases and pests, which, in his opinion constitute
a risk to Niue, he shall advise Customs that the plants, planting material or goods
are to be held under Customs and Post Office control until such time as the
quarantine officer is satisfied that the disease or pest has been eliminated.

7 Treatment

Where a quarantine officer has detained imported plants, plant material or
goods on the evidence of infection, or suspected infection he may order a treatment
as prescribed at the importer ’s expense.

8 Release of plants, plant material or goods

Provided all other requirements of these Regulations for the imported plant,
plant material or goods have been met and subsequent to satisfactory inspection
or satisfactory conclusion of a treatment as prescribed, the quarantine officer shall
advise Customs and Post Office that all requirements of these Regulations have
been met and that the imported plants, plant material or goods may be released to
the importer or owner.

9 Transport, storage, unpacking, treatment

Prior to the release of any imported plant, plant material or goods the
importer or owner may be required by the Director to provide for or meet the cost
of transport, unpacking, security storage, and treatment as prescribed including
cleaning and sorting.

10 Seizure and destruction

Any illegally imported plant, plant material including seeds, fruits, and
vegetables or regulated material without a permit may be seized by a quarantine
officer and treated by destruction by order of the senior quarantine officer.
60 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

11 Disposal of plant material

Any plant, plant material or goods imported under these Regulations but
on examination or re-examination the quarantine officer is satisfied that the plant,
plant material or goods is carrying or liable to be carrying a pest or disease and in
his opinion cannot be effectively treated to eradicate the pest or disease and if,
within a specified period of notification designated by the Director, the importer
has not re-exported or re-shipped the plant, plant material or goods the Director
shall order the destruction of the consignment of imported plants, plant material
or goods.

12 Inspection and treatment of conveyances

(1) Immediately on the arrival of any conveyance from any overseas
country, the conveyance together with its cargo and baggage may be inspected,
examined, and ordered for treatment by a quarantine officer and no person shall
enter the conveyance or remove any baggage or cargo from the conveyance without
the authority of the quarantine officer until the inspection, examination or treatment
is completed.
(2) The inspection and treatment may include inspection of conveyance,
its cargo and stores as well as treatment if necessary at the expense of the owner of
the conveyance and the spraying of every compartment of any conveyance as
prescribed.

13 Applications for permits

(1) Applications for permits to import shall require specific information
including –
(a) Full name, residential address and postal address of the importer;
(b) Name and address of exporter or persons from whom plant or plant
material will be obtained;
(c) Quantity and name (botanical name if approximate) of all material
proposed to import;
(d) Mode of transport, point of entry and approximate date of arrival.
(2) In granting any permits the Director shall give approval to import and
indicate conditions to be met to satisfy quarantine requirements.

14 Plant quarantine forms

The Director may devise such forms which are to be used by importers
desiring to import plant or plant material.

15 Official introduction by Government

(1) Official importations by the Director are exempt from the prohibitions
and restrictions hereafter in these Regulations.
(2) Such importations are to be subject to measures prescribed by the
Director to ensure absolute prevention of entry and dissemination of pests and
diseases.

16 Permit to land

A quarantine officer may issue a permit to land for any plants, plant material
or goods to enable inspection and treatment for quarantine purposes to be
undertaken.

Agriculture Quarantine 61

17 Quarantine for live plants

In lieu of post entry quarantine for live plants the Director may prescribe a
period of intermediate quarantine at an approved location overseas where the
plant material is to be established and screened as if undergoing post entry
quarantine.
PART 2
ENTRY OF PLANTS, PLANT MATERIAL, PESTS, GOODS

18 Entry of plant material capable of growth

(1) The entry of plants and planting material including cuttings, budwood,
stocks, tubers, corms, bulbs, suckers other than seed is limited to the smallest
quantity of propagating material consistent with good horticultural practices and
satisfactory establishment of the introduced cultivar.
(2) No live plants or planting material shall be introduced unless a permit
has been obtained from the Director in advance of arranging the import.
(3) Plants which have satisfactorily cleared intermediate quarantine at an
approved overseas location may be approved for import into Niue provided they
are free of soil, fumigated on arrival and established at an approved place.
(4) When the Director is satisfied that the imported plants are free of pest
and disease he may release them to the importer.

19 Entry of seed

(1) No agricultural or forest tree seed, except commercially packed flower
and vegetable seed other than tomato seed, and bean shall be introduced unless a
permit from the Director has been obtained.
(2) The entry of forest tree species is restricted to seeds which are inspected
and treated as prescribed.
(3) (a) All seed shall be free from injurious extraneous matter including
notified noxious weeds and shall be subject to such conditions as
the Director considers fit to require.
(b) All seed except flower and vegetable seed other than tomato and
bean shall be accompanied by a photosanitary certificate and other
specified accompanying documentation may include a seed analysis
report from the country of origin specifying extraneous foreign seeds
and materials.
(c) Upon arrival samples of seed may be taken for examination and if
necessary, in the opinion of the quarantine officer, treatment shall
be applied as prescribed.
(4) Seeds of annual crops with specifically restricted entry, such as peanuts
and maize, are to be grown overseas at an approved intermediate quarantine and
only seed produced in intermediate quarantine with no evidence of disease is to
be imported for release.
(5) Seeds such as citrus, coffee, coconut, cassava, sweet potato, taro,
provided they are from reliable sources approved by the Director, may be imported,
treated as directed prescribed, and grown at a location approved by the Director
prior to release.
(6) Seeds of tomato should be treated as prescribed before release.
(7) Seeds of beans (Phaseolus spp) may be required to have a certificate of
freedom from seed borne diseases.
62 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

20 Entry of fruits and vegetables

(1) (a) A permit must be obtained in advance for each importation of
admissible fresh fruit and vegetables.
(b) Admissibility of fresh fruit and vegetables will be determined by
the Director when an application for a permit is submitted.
(c) Entry status will be determined according to the pests present in
the exporting country.
(2) Importation of susceptible soft fleshy fruits and vegetables is prohibited
from all countries or parts of countries where dangerous fruit flies are known to
occur unless satisfactory treatments can be undertaken.
(3) Upon arrival any admissible fresh fruit and vegetables shall be
examined by a quarantine officer and if a pest or disease is detected treatment as
prescribed shall be applied before the fruit or vegetables are released to the
importer.
(4) Fresh fruit and vegetables without permits are to be seized and
destroyed.
(5) Frozen fruits and vegetables as well as canned or hermetically preserved
fruit and vegetables are admissible without permit.
(6) Dried or candied fruits and nuts and vegetables that have been prepared
in such a manner as to make them innocuous as pest carriers and are not otherwise
prohibited may enter without permit subject to inspection for verification of their
condition and freedom from pests.

21 Entry of timber

(1) Any timber imported from overseas shall be inspected for pests and
contamination.
(2) Where pests of concern or contamination such as bark are detected,
treatment as prescribed shall be required by the quarantine officer.
(3) All treatments shall be undertaken at the expense of the owner, importer
or agent and to the satisfaction of the quarantine officer before release from
quarantine is authorised.

22 Entry of cut and dried flowers

(1) Subject to these Regulations any cut flower, including foliage, may be
imported, if on inspection at the point of entry for the cut flowers are free from
pests and to contain no material capable of propagation.
(2) Subject to these Regulations any dried flower, including foliage, may
be introduced, if on inspection at the point of entry for the dried flowers are free
from pests but no dried flower of a plant producing agricultural seed or any plant
specifically prohibited or restricted under these regulations shall be introduced.

23 Entry of plant material not capable of growth

The entry of any plant material or plant product, particularly or wholly
manufactured, assessed by the Director as a potential carrier for an exotic serious
pest to agriculture or forestry in Niue is subject to permit, inspection and treatment
as prescribed if treatment is found necessary.

24 Entry of soil

(1) No person shall import any soil whether by itself or with any plant
material or as packing material in any form or adhering to any goods including
vehicles and machinery unless the quarantine officer is satisfied that the soil will
not introduce any pest.

Agriculture Quarantine 63

(2) Notwithstanding paragraph (1) peat, free of contamination with soil, may be admitted subject to inspection.
(3) Soil used in any conveyance as ballast is to be discharged under the directions of the Director or as prescribed.

25 Entry of non-plant articles

Non-plant articles contaminated with soil or infested with pests are subject
to such treatments, including cleaning, as directed by the Director or as prescribed.

26 Vessels from areas where rhinoceros beetle occurs

(1) Every ship arriving at Niue from any area infested by the Rhinoceros
beetle (Oryctes rhinoceros /L/) is required to keep at least 1 mile from the encircling
reef for at least 15 minutes before sunset until at least 15 minutes after sunrise.
(2) All aircraft arriving at Niue from a country infested by Rhinocerous
beetle are obliged to land before sunset except in the case of an emergency.

27 Entry of pests or cultures

No person shall import any living culture or organism including parasites,
predators, arachnids, molluscs, nematodes, fungi, bacteriat mycoplasma, parasitic
plant organism, plant pests or other invertebrate animal unless a specific written
permit has been issued by the Director in advance of the importation and only in
compliance with conditions imposed by such permit.

28 Entry of tissue culture of plants

(1) Tissue cultures of plants may be imported on the basis of a permit from
the Director and subject to inspection for contamination on arrival.
(2) Conditions of import may include certification of virus status.

29 Entry of honey bees

(1) The entry of all living stages of honey bee (Apis spp) shall be limited to
entries under permit from the Director under conditions as prescribed.
(2) Entry of used bee keeping equipment, such as hives and frames, is
prohibited.

30 Entry of material for research purposes

(1) Material imported under permit for research purposes is subject to
conditions of entry as stated on the permit issued by the Director.
(2) Conditions prescribed by the Director will be those that offer maximum
security against pest or disease dissemination.

31 Entry of packing material, used or second hand bags and dunnage

(1) No person shall introduce into Niue as packing any hay, straw, chaff,
soil, forest litter or compost.
(2) No person shall receive as packing material any substance except
sphagnum moss, woodwool, ground cork, charcoal, shredded paper, perlite, form
rubber chips, vegetable fibre free of pulp, granulated plastics or other material
approved by the Director.
(3) No second hand or used bags or any such packaging are to be used for
the import of any kind of goods.
(4) Any imported timber dunnage is to be treated as prescribed before
release or destroyed by incineration.
64 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

32 Entry of handicrafts made from plant material

If handicrafts do not contain any material prohibited under these
regulations, they may enter subject to inspection and treatment as required.

33 Exclusion of liability

Neither the Department of Agriculture nor any quarantine officer shall be
liable for any loss or damage resulting from the exercise of powers under these
regulations unless the loss or damage is caused otherwise than in the reasonable
exercise of these powers.
PART 3
GENERAL PROVISIONS

34 Specific prohibitions and restrictions

(1) The specific quarantine prohibitions and restrictions contained in the
Schedule shall apply in conformity with other conditions prescribed in these
Regulations.
(2) Additions may be made by notification from the Cabinet.

35 Emergency powers

If the Cabinet by proclamation under the Agriculture Quarantine Act 1984
has declared a state of agriculture emergency throughout all or any part of Niue
the emergency measures which may be taken by Cabinet or a person authorised
by Cabinet shall include –
(a) Declaring a specific disease affecting plants (or animals) or pests of
plants including noxious weeds to be a quarantine pest or disease;
(b) Defining a geographical area within Niue as a quarantine area or
the whole of Niue as a quarantine area;
(c) Control by quarantine officers or other authorised persons of the
movements of persons, plants, animals or goods into or out of the
quarantine area from or to any other part of Niue;
(d) Authority for the Director to notify in writing to the owner or owners
of land the measures to be taken aimed at eradication of the specific
quarantine disease or pest and destruction of plants or goods if
deemed necessary by the Director;
(e) Authority for the Department of Agriculture to undertake measures
including destruction mentioned in the previous clause if the owner
of the land cannot be contacted. The owner shall be obliged to
reimburse the Government for the costs incurred;
(f) Compilation of full details of each case of the owner of land so that
compensation, if any, can be properly assessed;
(g) Provision of a defined period for all the foregoing quarantine
measures to operate and provision for extension by Cabinet for
further appropriate periods considered necessary.

36 Export requirements

(1) An authorised quarantine officer may issue phytosanitary certificates
based on inspection of plants and plant material performed at the request of
exporters to aid them in meeting the entry requirements of the importing country.
(2) The certificates are to be issued only for plants or plant material
produced in Niue.
(3) The issuance of a phytosanitary certificate in no way releases the
importer from compliance with any import regulations of the country to which

Agriculture Quarantine 65

the plants or plant material are consigned.
(4) The phytosanitary certificate used is to be substantially based on the
model adopted by the International Plant Protection Convention of 1951, as
amended in 1979.

37 Fees

Any treatment or destruction shall be carried out at the expense of the
importer at such rates determined by the Director.
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE

1 Banana, abaca and other “musacaea”

(1) The inflow of plants and corms is prohibited.
(2) Tissue cultures may be imported under permit provided these are
accompanied by a phytosanitary certificate certifying freedom from virus including
Bunchy top disease.
(3) (a) Fruit of banana may be imported only with a permit issued by the
Director.
(b) When issuing the permit the Director may stipulate pre-export
treatment in the country of origin.

2 Beans (phaseolus spp)

Seed of Phaseolus spp is prohibited import except by permit of the Director.

3 Cassava (Manihot esculenta) Crantz

The import of plants of Manihot esculenta Crantz is prohibited except that
seed and tissue cultures may be imported under permit issued by the Director.

4 Citrus

(1) All planting material including budwood and except fruit and seed is
prohibited.
(2) (a) Citrus fruit is prohibited from all countries where Citrus canker
(Xanthomonas campestri p.v. Citri Hasse) Dye occurs.
(b) Citrus fruit may enter only with a permit granted by the Director,
issued under conditions he considers appropriate.
(3) Citrus seed free of pulp is permitted entry subject to a permit inspection,
and treatment as prescribed.
(4) Citrus includes the following genera: citropsis, citrus, eremocitrus,
fortunella, microcitrus, monanthocitrus, pleurocitrus and poncirus.

5 Coconuts (Cocos mucifera N( �/p>

(1) Import of seedlings and suckers of all the family Palmae is prohibited.
(2) Import of seednuts and pollen is prohibited except by special permit
from the Director.
(3) Conditions of the permit include selected approved sources, mandatory
growth in quarantine and restriction of quantity not to exceed 100 for each line.
(4) No person shall introduce coconuts for consumption or processing
unless the consignment was fumigated at the time of shipment or at destination
before delivery as prescribed.
66 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

6 Coffee (coffee spp)

(1) All planting material of coffee spp except seed is prohibited.
(2) Viable seed may be imported under special permit of the Director from
specified selected locations for scientific purposes, treated as prescribed by the
Director and grown under close surveillance in quarantine.

7 Ginger (Zingiber officinale Rose)

All plants of the Zingiberaceae family are prohibited except by permit of
the Director.

8 Mango (Mangifera indica L.)

All plant material of Manigera indica including fruit is prohibited import
except by permit of the Director.

9 Maize (Zea mays L.)

(1) All plant material of maize (Zea mays L.) except seed is prohibited.
(2) Seed may be imported only by permit issued by the Director.

10 Peanut (Arachis hypogaea L.)

All plant material of Arachis hypogaea L. is prohibited except for seed which
may be imported only with a permit from the Director.

11 Sugar cane (Saccharum officinarum L.)

The import of all plant material including the seed of Saccharum officinarum
L. is prohibited except by permit issued by the Director.

12 Sweet Potato (Ipomoea batatast L.Lam)

The importation of plant material of Ipomoea batatas L. Lam is prohibited
except by permit issued by the Director.

13 Tomato Lycopersicon esculentum Miller

The import of seed of Lycopersicon esculentum Miller is prohibited except
by permit of the Director.

14 Pineapple (Ananas cosmosus /L/Merriln( �/p>

The import of planting material including the fruit of Ananas cosmosus (1)
Merrill is prohibited except by permit issued by the Director.

15 Rubber (Hevea spp.)

The import of all plant material including the seed of all species of Hevea
is prohibited.

16 Taro and other aroids (Alocasia spp. Colocasia spp. Xanthosomas spp. and Cyrtosperma spp.)

(1) Vegetative planting material is prohibited except by permit issued by the Director with provisions that roots/corms be free of soil, treated and devitalised as prescribed and inspected on arrival.
(2) Seeds and tissue culture may be imported with a permit from the
Director under prescribed conditions.
67

ARMS

ARMS REGISTRATION (FEES) REGULATIONS 2005

2005/1 – 24 June 2003

1

Title

These are the Arms (Fees) Regulations 2005.

2

Fees for permits and certificates

The fees payable for the issue of permits and certificates –

Permit to import firearm

$80.00

Certificate to register firearm for the first time

$30.00

Annual licence

$15.00

68 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

69

BROADCASTING

BROADCASTING REGULATIONS 1989

1989/1 – 1 July 1989

1

Title

9

Default in payment

2

Interpretation

10

Fees for other services

3

Sitting allowances for Directors

11

Unregistered users

4

Registration of owners of television

12

Offence for unlawful use

installations

13

Powers of Corporation to conduct inquiries

5

Register to be kept

14

Powers of Corporation to take legal

6

Effect of registration

proceedings

7

Annual fee for television

8

Payment of annual fee

SCHEDULE

1 Title

These are the Broadcasting Regulations 1989.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Broadcasting Act 1989;
“Director” means a Director of the Corporation appointed under section
10 of the Act;
“person” includes any company, or business or organisation, or other
statutory body but does not include the Crown in right of the
Government of Niue or any department or office of the Government;
“television installation” means an apparatus designed to receive by means
of electric or electromagnetic energy, either with or without artificial
guide, sounds and visual images.
(2) Subject to paragraph (1), the expressions defined in the Act have the
meanings so defined.

3 Sitting allowances for Directors

(1) Every Director of the Corporation shall be paid an allowance of $40
per meeting for every meeting that Director attends.
(2) The allowances payable to the Directors shall be a charge upon the
funds of the Corporation.

4 Registration of owners of television installations

(1) [Spent]
(2) Any person who becomes an owner or user of a television installation
which receives or is being used to receive transmissions from Television Niue
shall, as soon as practicable and in no case later than 21 days after the date he
70 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
receives transmission from Television Niue, inform the Corporation of that fact for the purposes of having his name registered as a person to which these Regulations apply.

5 Register to be kept

For the purposes of regulation 4, the Corporation shall keep a register of all
persons receiving transmissions from Television Niue.

6 Effect of registration

(1) Every person registered under the foregoing regulations shall, upon
due registration but subject to regulations 7 and 8, acquire the rights to receive
transmissions from Television Niue.
(2) A person falling under paragraph (1) is a ‘registered user ’.

7 Annual fee for television

(1) Every registered user shall, in respect of acquiring rights to receive
television transmissions from Television Niue, be charged an annual fee by the
Corporation.
(2) The amount of the annual fee shall be $260.

8 Payment of annual fee

(1) The annual fee shall be paid to the Corporation on a quarterly basis,
falling due on the 1st day of the months of January, April, July and October in
each year.
(2) Every payment shall be made no later than 14 days after the day it is
due.
(3) [Spent]
(4) Any registered user who fails to pay the fee on or before the time
provided under this Regulation shall, as from the date of such default, be regarded as a person in default to whom regulation 9 apply.
(5) Notwithstanding paragraph (1) any registered user may pay the full annual fee in one instalment.

9 Default in payment

(1) Any registered user who defaults in payment under regulation 8(1)
shall for every day of such default be charged a penalty interest of 2% on the
amount due.
(2) Any person who defaults in excess of 21 days shall, on the day
immediately after that 21 days no longer be regarded as a registered user, and
thereupon, becomes a person to whom regulations 11 and 12 apply.

10 Fees for other services

For the purposes of advertisements, notices, or other services to be provided
by the Corporation, the rates to be charged by the Corporation are those as set out
in the Schedule.

11 Unregistered users

No person, other than a registered user under these Regulations shall have
any rights to receive, abstract, or use any television transmission from Television
Niue.

Broadcasting 71

12 Offence for unlawful use

(1) For the purposes of section 188 of the Niue Act 1966, it is hereby declared
that television transmission is a thing capable of being stolen.
(2) Any person who is not a registered user or who is a person to whom
regulation 9(2) applies, who knowingly or fraudulently receives, abstracts, or uses
television transmission from Television Niue commits theft and upon conviction
is liable to punishment as provided under section 192 of the Niue Act 1966.
POWERS OF CORPORATION

13 Powers of Corporation to conduct inquiries

(1) The Corporation shall have the power to conduct inquiries as may be
necessary to ensure compliance with these Regulations.
(2) Without limiting the powers of the Corporation under paragraph (1)
the Corporation shall have the power to authorise any of its officers to –
(a) Enter any place, premises or building;
(b) Obtain information from any person or occupant of such place,
premises or building;
(c) Conduct any tests to ascertain whether or not any television
installation in such place, premises, or building is receiving
transmissions from Television Niue.
(3) No officer shall enter any place, premises or building without first giving
notice to the owner or occupier of any such place, premises, or building.
(4) In the exercise of the powers under this regulation, the Corporation
shall ensure that as little inconvenience as possible is caused to the owners or
occupants of any place, premises or building.

14 Powers of Corporation to take legal proceedings

(1) For the purposes of these Regulations, the Corporation may take legal
proceedings in its own motion through its officers, or through an appointed agent
or attorney, or through the Niue Police.
(2) Any proceedings under regulation 12 may include proceedings for the
recovery of any fees due to the Corporation under regulation 7 or 10.
––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

A

TELEVISION

(a)

Advertising – Daily Rates

Sponsorship

$25 per programme

From commencement of transmission up to

15 minutes before news time

$5 for up to 30 seconds

From 15 minutes before the news and during

breaks in the news

$10 for up to 30 seconds

After news to close of transmission

$8 for up to 30 seconds

72 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

(b) Advertising – Weekly Rates

From commencement to news time

$15 for up to 30 seconds

One each day

After news to close of transmission

$20 for up to 30 seconds

One each day

(c) Other Services

Filming of special functions or occasions

eg hair cutting, weddings, etc

$250

Production of commercials

$50

B RADIO

(a) Advertising

Morning

One call

$3 for up to 30 seconds

Three calls

$5 for up to 30 seconds

Weekly rate for two calls

each day, Monday to Friday

$12 for up to 30 seconds

Lunch hour

One call

$2 for 30 seconds

Three calls

$4 for up to 30 seconds

Weekly rate for two calls

each day, Monday to Friday

$10 for up to 30 seconds

Evening

One call

$3 for up to 30 seconds

Two calls

$4 for up to 30 seconds

Weekly rate for two calls

each day Monday to Friday

$6 for up to 30 seconds

(b) Public Notices

One call

$3 for up to 30 seconds

Three calls

$5 for up to 30 seconds

(c) Buy, Sell or Swap (private not business)

One call

$3 for up to 30 seconds

Three calls

$5 for up to 30 seconds

(d) Entertaining/Fundraising

One call

$3 for up to 30 seconds

Three calls

$5 for up to 30 seconds

(e) Birthday Calls

One call $3

73

BUILDING CODE

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The National Building Code 1990 is not reproduced. Copies of it may be attained from the Director of Works.]

74 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

75

BUSINESS LICENCE

BUSINESS LICENCE REGULATIONS 1997

1997/5 – 18 February 1997

1 Short title

These are the Business Licence Regulations 1997.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations “Act” means the Business Licence Act 1997.

3 Fees payable

Fees payable by an applicant for the purpose of acquiring a licence under
the Act are –
(a) For each wholesaler ’s licence $30.00 per annum
(b) For each retailer ’s licence $30.00 per annum
(c) For each service provider ’s licence $30.00 per annum
(d) True copies of licence $10.00 for each copy
(e) Payment for advertising new business $20.00 per application.

76 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

77

CHATTELS TRANSFER

CHATTELS TRANSFER FEES REGULATIONS 1967

1 Title

These are the Chattels Transfer Fees Regulations 1967.

2 Fees

There shall be paid to the Registrar for the various matters set out in the
Schedule the respective fees set out in that Schedule.
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
FEES TO BE PAID TO THE REGISTRAR UNDER THE CHATTELS TRANSFER ACT 1924.
$ Registration of any instrument .......................................................................... 2.00
Renewal of registration of any instrument ...................................................... 2.00
Registration of transfer of instrument, in respect of each instrument
transferred ........................................................................................................ 2.00
Filing memorandum of satisfaction or of partial satisfaction and entry
thereof, in respect of each instrument satisfied or partly satisfied .......... 1.00
Searching register books, indices, and instruments; for every search
against any one person ................................................................................... 0.30
Provided that where any person regularly searches every instrument
(other than a transfer) filed in the Registrar ’s office the fee shall be
15 cents for every instrument searched by that person.
For a copy of or an extract of or from any document, for each half-sheet
of foolscap or part of such a half sheet –

When typed ......................................................................................................

1.00

When reproduced by photographic or other copying process ................

0.50

For certifying a copy of or an extract of or from any document ..............

1.00

78 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

79

CHILD ALLOWANCE

CHILD ALLOWANCE (FEES) REGULATIONS 2004

2004/3 – 1 July 2004

1 Title

These are the Child Allowance (Fees) Regulations 2004.

2 Interpretation

(1) Expressions in these Regulations have the same meaning as they have
in the Act.
(2) In these Regulations, “Act” means the Child Allowance Act 1995.

3 Rate of child allowance

(1) The rate of child allowance payable under section 4 of the Act shall
be –
(a) $100 grant for every newborn child to a non-public servant mother;
and
(b) $340 per annum for every qualifying child.
(2) Child allowance is payable under the Act in respect of each child who
on 1 January of that year was a qualifying child or becomes a qualifying child on or before 30 June of that year.

4 Payment of child allowance

(1) Child allowance is payable –
(a) Once for a newborn child to a non-public servant mother shortly
after giving birth; and
(b) In advance by equal payments on a quarterly basis or on the day
which is one week before the first day of each school term in a year.
(2) Where under regulation 4(1)(b), a child becomes a qualifying child on
or before 30 June in a year any unpaid child allowance payable in respect of that
child for that year is to be paid on the next day of child allowance.

80 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

81

CIVIL AVIATION

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The legislation listed in the Table of Subsidiary Legislation in Force is not reproduced. It has been superseded by the Civil Aviation Rules of New Zealand made under section 32(1) of the Civil Aviation Act 1990 (NZ). The Rules are accessible at http:// www.caa.govt.nz/rules/rules.htm. The other subsidiary is listed for early repeal.]

82 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

83

COMMUNICATIONS

RADIO REGULATIONS 1972

SR 1972/128 – 1 July 1972

1

Title

2

Interpretation

3

Application to stations on ships and aircraft

PART 1

GENERAL MATTERS

4

Application

5

Cabinet may establish radiocommunic­

ation systems

6

Delegation of Cabinet’s powers

7

Cabinet may cause inquiry to be made

8

Licence or construction permit required for

a station

9

Construction permit may lapse if certain

conditions not met

10

Classes of licences that may be granted

11

Transmitting station licence to include both

the transmitting and receiving apparatus

12

Superintendent’s decision final

13

Terms, conditions and restrictions, in

connection with licence or construction

permit

14

Apparatus to comply with technical

specifications

15

Period of validity of licence

16

Cabinet may refuse to grant application for

licence

17

Transmitting station licences issued only to

British subjects

18

Licence for a corporate body

19

Licence personal to licensee

20

Fee payable for licence

21

Commencing date for licensing year

22

Short-term licence

23

Back dating of licence

24

Licence fee for initial period

25

Cabinet may issue licence without payment

of prescribed fee

26

Licence subject to respective limitations and

restrictions

27

Non-liability of Niue Public Service

28

Application of International Radio

Regulations 56 Copy of telegram

84 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

57 Restricted radiation devices

58 Control of stations in emergency

59 Inspection of stations

60 Licence, permit, or authorisation to be

available

61 Duplicate copy of licence

62 Requirements where breach committed

against the Act or Regulations

63 Suspension or revocation of licence, permit,

certificate, or authorisation

64 Notice of suspension or revocation

65 Failure to surrender licence, permit,

certificate, or authorisation

66 Service of notice, request, or consent

67 Penalty where no other penalty provided

PART 2

OPERATORS CERTIFICATES, AUTHORISATIONS AND

EXAMINATIONS

68 Classes of certificates

69 Form of certificate or authorisation

70 Terms, conditions and restrictions in

connection with certificate or authorisation

71 Cabinet may refuse to grant application for

an operators certificate or authorisation

72 Operators certificates issued only to New

Zealand citizens

73 Recognition of Commonwealth operators

certificate

74 Conditions for the conduct of examinations

75 Minimum age limit

76 Examination for radiotelegraph operators

special certificate

77 Endorsement of certificate for

radiotelegraph service only

78 Examination for radiotelephone operators

certificate

79 Examination for land radiotelephone

operators certificate

80 Examination for amateur operators

PART 3

MOBILE STATIONS

85 Types of licences

86 Limitation applying to ship stations

87 Distress calls and distress messages

88 Station in distress may use any means at

its disposal to attract attention

89 Ship stations licensed to engage in public

correspondence

90 Ship stations employing radiotelephony not licensed to engage in public correspondence

91 Ship stations employing radiotelephony not licensed to engage in public correspondence

92 Accounts, payments, and retention of records

93 Documents to be carried by ship stations

94 Ship stations operating in bands between

405 kHz and 535 kHz

95 Ship stations operating in bands between

1605 kHz and 2850 kHz

96 Ship stations operating in bands between

156 MHz and 174 MHz

97 Ship stations to keep listening watch on 500

kHz

98 Ship stations to keep listening watch on

2182 kHz

99 Inspection of ship stations

100 Prevention of transmissions from ships in

harbour in special circumstances

101 Notice of detention of a ship

102 Qualifications of operators of land mobile

stations

103 Penalty where no other penalty provided

PART 4

LAND STATIONS

104 Types of licences

105 Coast stations operating in bands between

405 kHz and 535 kHz

106 Coast stations operating in bands between

1605 kHz and 2850 kHz

107 Coast stations operating in bands between

156 MHz and 174 MHz

108 Coast stations to keep listening watch on

500 kHz

109 Coast stations to keep listening watch on

2182 kHz

110 Qualifications of operators of coast stations

111 Qualifications of operators of base stations

PART 5

FIXED STATIONS

112 Scope of licences

113 Qualifications of operators

PART 6

AMATEUR STATIONS

114 Scope of licences

115 Persons to whom licences may be issued

116 Qualifications of operators

117 Issue of authorisation to non-citizen

118 Temporary operation at a different address

119 Communication permitted with other

amateur stations only

Communications 85

120 Handling of third party messages recordings prohibited without prior prohibited approval

121 Licensees not to engage in 124 Power permitted

radiocommunication for hire or material 125 Harmful interference to broadcast

compensation reception

122 Limitation on class of message

123 Transmission of news, entertainment, or SCHEDULES

––––––––––––––––––––

1 Title

These are the Radio Regulations 1972.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Communications Act 1989;
“aerial” means the electrical conductor or system of conductors used for
effecting radiocommunication and includes any pole, insulator,
staywire, or other equipment or material used or intended to be used
for supporting, enclosing, surrounding, or protecting any such
conductor or system of conductors;
“aircraft station” means a mobile station on board an aircraft;
“amateur service” means a radiocommunication service carried on by duly
authorised persons interested in radio technique by way of
intercommunication and technical investigation solely with a personal
aim and without pecuniary interest;
“apparatus” means any apparatus intended for the purpose of effecting
radiocommunication, whether by transmission or reception, or both;
“authorised officer” in relation to these Regulations means an officer
authorised by Cabinet for the purpose of that provision;
“base station” means a land station in the land mobile service carrying on
a service with land mobile stations;
“broadcasting service” means a radiocommunication service in which the
transmissions, whether by way of sound, television, or otherwise, are
intended for direct reception by the general public;
“coast station” means a land station in the maritime mobile service;
“Department” means the Telecommunications Department and includes
the Superintendent and any authorised officer;
“fixed service” means a service of radiocommunication between specified
fixed points;
“fixed station” means a station in the fixed service;
“harmful interference” means any emission, radiation, or induction which
endangers the functioning of a radionavigation service or of other safety
services or seriously degrades, obstructs, or repeatedly interrupts a
radiocommunication service operating under these Regulations;
“International Radio Regulations” means the radio regulations annexed
to the International Telecommunication Convention, Montreux 1965,
and includes any regulations made in amendment, addition, or
substitution for the said radio regulation;
“land mobile service” means a mobile service between base stations and
land mobile stations, or between land mobile stations;
“land mobile station” means a mobile station in the land mobile service
capable of surface movement within the geographical limits of the
country;
86 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
“land station” means a station in the mobile service not intended to be used while in motion or during halts at unspecified points;
“licence” means a licence under these Regulations, for the installation and working of radio stations, or for the erection, construction, establishment, maintenance, or use of radio apparatus capable of transmitting or receiving radiocommunications within Niue or on any Niuean ship;
“licensee” means any person to whom a licence is granted under these
Regulations;
“maritime mobile service” means a mobile service between coast stations
and ship stations or between ship stations in which survival craft
stations may also participate;
“mobile service” means a service of radiocommunication between mobile
stations and land stations, or between mobile stations;
“mobile station” means a station in the mobile service intended to be used
while in motion or during halts at unspecified points;
“operate” means to be in control of the functioning of radio receiving
apparatus, or of radio transmitting apparatus while it is emitting
radiations, or in control of the matter radiated by any such apparatus,
but does not apply to any person while being the user of the public
radiotelephone service; or to any person in respect of announcements
made from a broadcasting station;
“operator” means any person duly authorised by these regulations to
operate radio transmitting apparatus or radio receiving apparatus;
“premises” means any building, site, vehicle, vessel or structure, or any
group of buildings within the same site or boundary and forming part
of the same establishment, or any part of any building or site under
separate occupation or tenancy;
“public correspondence” means any communication which any station
must, by reason of its being operated as a public service for the
convenience of the general public, accept for transmission;
“radiocommunication” means any transmission, emission, or reception of
signs, signals, impulses, writing, images, sounds, or intelligence of any
nature, including pulsed radio-frequency emissions, by the free
radiation in space of electromagnetic waves of frequencies between 10
kilohertz and 3,000 gigahertz;
“radio station” and “station” mean one or more transmitters or receivers
or a combination of transmitters and receivers, including the accessory
equipment, necessary at one location for carrying on a
radiocommunication service classified by the service in which it
operates permanently or temporarily;
“radiotelegraphy” means a system of radiocommunication for the
transmission of any kind of information by the use of a signal code;
“radiotelephony” means a system of radiocommunicaiton for the
transmission of speech or other sounds;
“restricted radiation device” means a device which radiates electromagnetic
energy either incidentally to or as an essential element of its operation;
“ship station” means a mobile station in the maritime mobile service located
on board a vessel other than a survival craft, which is not permanently
moored;

Communications 87

“Superintendent” means the Director of the Telecommunications Department of Government and includes any officer of the Niue Public Service acting for the time being in the place of the Superintendent of Radio, whether during any vacancy in that office or otherwise;
“survival craft” means a lifeboat, liferaft, or other survival equipment intended solely for survival purposes;
“telegram” means any written matter intended to be transmitted by radiotelegraphy or radiotelephony for delivery to an addressee.

3 Application to stations on ships and aircraft

Unless otherwise expressly provided herein, these Regulations shall be
applicable to all radio stations established on any Niuean ship, and also to all
radio stations established on ships or other vessels that are not Niuean ships during
the time the ships or other vessels are within the territorial waters or harbours of
Niue, and shall similarly be applicable to all aircraft stations on or over Niuean
territory notwithstanding that the aircraft may not be registered in Niue.

4 Application

PART 1
GENERAL MATTERS
The Regulations contained in this Part shall apply to every class of radio station except such stations as may be specifically exempted herein.

5 Cabinet may establish radiocommunication systems

(1) Nothing in these Regulations shall prejudice or affect the right of Cabinet
to establish, extend, maintain and work any system or systems of
radiocommunication (whether of a like nature to those licensed hereunder or
otherwise) in such manner as it shall think fit.
(2) Nothing in these Regulations shall prejudice or affect the right of Cabinet
to enter into agreements for or to grant licences relative to the working and use of
radio stations (whether of a like nature to those licensed hereunder or otherwise)
for the transmission or reception of messages in any part of Niue by means of
radiocommunication, or by any other means, with or to any person or persons
whomsoever, upon such terms as Cabinet thinks fit.
(3) Except as expressly provided in these Regulations, nothing herein
contained shall be deemed to authorise any licensee to exercise any of the powers
or authorities conferred on or acquired by Cabinet by or under the Act.

6 Delegation of Cabinet’s powers

Any of the powers or authorities given to Cabinet by these Regulations
may be delegated by Cabinet to such officer or officers of the Niue Public Service
as Cabinet thinks fit.

7 Cabinet may cause inquiry to be made

Cabinet may cause inquiry to be made into any matter connected with these
Regulations or arising thereunder, in such manner as he thinks fit, and licensees
and operators shall comply strictly with every requirement of Cabinet made
pursuant to any such inquiry.
88 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

8 Licence or construction permit required for a station

(1) (a) Except as provided in these Regulations, every person who, not
being the holder of a licence authorising him to do so, erects,
constructs, establishes, maintains, or uses any apparatus capable
of transmitting radiocommunications, or is in possession of any
apparatus capable of receiving radiocommunications, commits an
offence and shall be liable accordingly.
(b) Before the issue of a licence, the Superintendent may issue a permit
for the construction and testing of a station for which application
for a licence has been made, and which is capable during that
construction or testing, or at any time whatsoever, of generating
electric waves likely to interfere with radiocommunication, and that
subject to regulation 9, for the purposes of this regulation, any such
construction permit shall be deemed to be a licence until revoked,
or if not revoked, until such time as a licence shall have been issued.
(2) Notwithstanding paragraph (1) that paragraph shall not apply in respect
of apparatus for the reception of radiocommunications in the broadcasting service.

9 Construction permit may lapse if certain conditions not met

Any construction permit issued by the Superintendent under regulation 8
shall, unless extended by the Superintendent, be deemed to have lapsed if
construction of the station has not been completed within 6 months from the date
of the granting of the permit.

10 Classes of licences that may be granted

The following classes of licences may be granted, and shall be in such form
as Cabinet approves in that behalf –
(a) For transmitting stations –
(i) ship station licence;
(ii) land mobile station licence;
(iii) land station licence;
(iv) fixed station licence;
(v) amateur station licence;
(b) For receiving stations –
(i) ship station receiving licence;
(ii) land mobile station receiving licence;
(iii) land station receiving licence;
(iv) fixed station receiving licence.

11 Transmitting station licence to include both the transmitting and receiving apparatus

A transmitting station licence shall cover both transmitting apparatus and receiving apparatus at the station.

12 Superintendent’s decision final

The Superintendent shall decide the class of licence and the number of
licences to which any person is entitled in respect of any existing or proposed
radio station, and his decision shall be final.

Communications 89

13 Terms, conditions, and restrictions, in connection with licence or construction permit

Cabinet may, in connection with any licence or construction permit, impose such terms, conditions, and restrictions, not inconsistent with the Act or these Regulations as it thinks fit.

14 Apparatus to comply with technical specifications

Cabinet may require that any apparatus used in any radiocommunication
service shall comply either in whole or in part with any technical specifications
issued in that behalf by the Superintendent.

15 Period of validity of licence

Except where otherwise provided in these Regulations, every licence issued
under these Regulations shall be in force from the time of the granting until the
date of expiration shown thereon (if any), or until suspended or revoked.

16 Cabinet may refuse to grant application for licence

Cabinet may refuse to grant an application for any class of radio licence.

17 Transmitting station licences issued only to New Zealand subjects

No transmitting licence shall be issued to anyone other than a New Zealand
subject except at the discretion of Cabinet and subject to such terms, conditions
and restrictions as Cabinet thinks fit.

18 Licence for a corporate body

(1) Where the applicant for a licence is a corporate body, any individual
through whom the application is made shall satisfy the Superintendent that he is
duly authorised to make the application in the name and on behalf of the corporate
body.
(2) Where a licence is sought for a station vested in any person in trust for an association, institute, or other body of unincorporated persons, the applicant shall satisfy the Superintendent that he is or is to be the person to erect, construct, establish, maintain, and use the apparatus or that he is the person in possession of the station or apparatus in respect of which the licence is sought.

19 Licence personal to licensee

(1) Every licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation issued or enuring
under these regulations shall be personal to the licensee or holder, and no licensee
or the holder of any permit, certificate, or authorisation, shall assign, sublet, transfer,
or otherwise dispose of, or for the purpose of profit admit any other person or
body to participate in the benefit of any such licence, permit, certificate, or
authorisation.
(2) The Superintendent or any person authorised by him in that behalf
shall have the power, in any case at his sole and entire discretion to waive this
requirement by giving prior consent in writing to any such disposal or admission
and such consent shall enure only for the purpose of that disposal and admission
and no subsequent disposal or admission.
90 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

20 Fee payable for licence

(1) Except as otherwise provided in these Regulations, the fee payable in
respect of any licence under these regulations shall be the appropriate fee
prescribed in Schedule 1.
(2) In the case of a station performing the service of both a land station
and a fixed station, the fee for the licence for the station shall be the fee prescribed
in clause 4 of Schedule 1.
(3) The fee for a receiving station licence under regulation 10 (b) shall be
half the fee prescribed for a transmitting station licence of the same class.

21 Commencing date for licensing year

Except as provided in these Regulations, the fee payable for any licence
described in regulation 10 shall be the fee for the full licensing year, which shall be
deemed to commence as follows –
(a) For a ship station licence: on the first day of January;
(b) For a land station licence, a land mobile station licence, or a fixed
station licence: on the first day of April;
(c) For an amateur station licence: on the first day of the month of issue.

22 Short-term licence

The Superintendent may issue a licence for a station or stations in the fixed
service or the land mobile service for a period not exceeding 28 days.

23 Back dating of licence

(1) Where a person applies for a licence in respect of any apparatus capable
of transmitting or receiving radiocommunications, and before the grant of the
licence he, without being the holder of a licence for the time being in force
authorising the act, did any act in respect of the apparatus which, in accordance
with these regulations, may only be done by the holder of a current licence, the
licence applied for may be dated as of the date on which he first did the act.
(2) In any proceedings for an offence against these Regulations a licence
shall not be deemed to have been in force before the date on which it was granted.

24 Licence fee for initial period

In the case of a transmitting station licence (other than an amateur station
licence) where the period to the end of the licensing year does not exceed 3 months
and the licence is also taken out for the ensuing year or part of the year, the fee for
the initial period shall be one-fourth of the annual fee and shall be added to the
full annual fee for the ensuing licensing year.

25 Cabinet may issue licence without payment of prescribed fee

Notwithstanding anything in these Regulations, where in the opinion of
Cabinet any such action is warranted, Cabinet may issue a licence without payment
of the prescribed fee or upon payment of a reduced fee.

26 Licence subject to respective limitations and restrictions

Every radio licence shall be deemed to be subject to the respective limitations
and restrictions contained in these regulations in respect of a licence of the class
concerned as if those limitations and restrictions were set out expressly in the
licence.

Communications 91

27 Non-liability of Cabinet or Niue Public Service

Neither Cabinet nor the Niue Public Service shall be liable in respect of any
action, claim, or demand that may be brought or made by any person in respect of
any bodily injury or damage to property or any other circumstances arising from
any act permitted by a licence issued under these regulations.

28 Application of International Radio Regulations

The International Radio Regulations shall, except as may otherwise be
provided in these regulations, apply to every licence issued by Cabinet, and every
licensee shall observe any such provisions as far as they apply to the particular
class of licence held by the licensee.

29 Radiocommunication restricted to services indicated in licence

Subject to these Regulations, a licence issued under these Regulations shall
not authorise the licensee to take part in any radiocommunication service other
than the services indicated in the licence.

30 Competition with Government communication services prohibited

(1) Except with the authority of Cabinet a radio station shall not be used in
any way to compete with Government communication services, and shall not
transmit or receive radiocommunications the transmission or reception of which
is calculated, in the judgment of Cabinet, to cause loss of revenue to the Department.
(2) In an emergency, communications having for their object the preservation
of human life, the protection of property, or the detection of crime, may be
transmitted or received without reference to Cabinet.

31 Station to be used for authorised radiocommunications only

Neither the licensee nor any other person shall use, nor shall the licensee
cause or permit any person to use, any radio station for the transmission or
reception of radiocommunications except such radiocommunications as are
authorised by these Regulations.

32 Cabinet may grant extension of normal terms of licence

Where difficulties inherent to the nature of radiocommunication may be
overcome by a reasonable extension of the normal terms of any licence issued
under these Regulations Cabinet may grant to the licensee, in writing, such
extension of the terms as in the opinion of Cabinet may be necessary in the
circumstances.

33 Observance of conditions and provisions of licence and of regulations

Every licensee of a radio station shall faithfully observe and cause to be
observed all the conditions and provisions of the licence and of these Regulations
as far as they are applicable.

34 Licensee personally responsible for observance of regulations and other conditions imposed

Notwithstanding any approval that may be given to the licensee by Cabinet for any person other than the licensee to operate any radio station, the licensee shall be personally responsible for the observance of these Regulations and all other conditions imposed as if the station were operated by the licensee.
92 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

35 Infringement of copyright or patent

The issue of a licence under these Regulations shall not relieve the licensee
of responsibility for infringement of copyright or of any patent for an invention,
or for compliance with any other Regulations, instructions, or rules which may be
applicable.

36 Licence exercisable in respect of 1 address only

Subject to the provisions of these Regulations, a radio station licence, except
a licence for a mobile station, shall authorise any act covered by the licence only at
the particular address stated in the licence and shall not extend to anywhere else.

37 Dismantling or removal of station

In the event of a radio station licensed under these Regulations being
dismantled, or (except in the case of a mobile station) removed from the particular
address stated in the licence, the licensee shall, within 7 days thereafter, notify the
Superintendent in writing accordingly.

38 Proposed alterations to transmitting apparatus to be notified

Any proposed alteration affecting the technical characteristics or the location
or the functioning of the transmitting apparatus at any radio station shall be notified
in writing to the Superintendent.

39 Harmful interference to other stations

The licensee of any radio station shall operate the station in such manner
as not to cause harmful interference and shall comply with all such directions and
conditions as may be given or made by the Superintendent for that purpose.

40 Harmful interference suffered by reason of deficiencies in receiving apparatus

It shall not be a breach of regulation 39 if any harmful interference is, in the opinion of the Superintendent, suffered by any receiving apparatus by reason of its being of inferior design or construction or being incapable of such minimum technical performance as he may prescribe.

41 Directive aerials

Wherever the nature of the service permits, and if directed by the
Superintendent, directive aerials shall be employed.

42 Erection of aerials

Aerials shall not, without the consent of Cabinet, be erected above or below
any lines erected and maintained by the Department, or sufficiently near any such
lines to permit contact with them should any such lines or the aerial fail.

43 Levels of spurious emissions

(1) The licensee shall ensure that the levels of spurious emission of a station
are kept at the lowest value which the general state of development of radio
apparatus permits and in any case the levels of spurious emissions shall be
maintained within the limits prescribed by the International Radio Regulations.
(2) The Superintendent may set any limit lower than that prescribed by
the International Radio Regulations for the maximum permissible value of any
spurious emission in which case the licensee shall ensure that the levels of spurious
emissions do not exceed this lower limit so set.

Communications 93

44 No monopoly of allotted frequency

(1) The allocation of any frequency to any transmitting station shall not be
held to confer upon the licensee or upon the station so licensed, a monopoly of the
use of that frequency.
(2) The Superintendent may, and subject to such terms, conditions, and
restrictions as he thinks fit, allocate to any licensee a frequency for the exclusive
use of the licensee’s station or stations so licensed.

45 Operator of transmitting station to hold valid certificate

Except as otherwise provided in these Regulations, or in the case of an
emergency involving the safety of life or property, no person shall operate the
apparatus at a transmitting station licensed under these Regulations unless he is
the holder of a valid certificate of the required class, or an authorisation issued, or
in the case of a certificate recognised by Cabinet.

46 Allocation of callsign

The Superintendent shall allot to every transmitting station licensed under
these Regulations a callsign by which the station shall be identified.

47 Transmission of callsign

Except as otherwise directed by the Superintendent, each transmitting
station shall transmit its callsign as frequently as practicable, and in any event at
least once in each hour during the course of transmission.

48 Impersonation

No person shall, by means of a radio station, impersonate any other person,
or pass off that radio station to be any other radio station, or use the callsign of
another radio station improperly, or without lawful justification.

49 False, fictitious, or misleading radiocommunication or distress signal or call

No person shall transmit or cause or permit to be transmitted any radiocommunicaton of a false, fictitious, or misleading character, and in particular but without prejudice to the foregoing, transmit or cause or permit to be transmitted any false or deceptive distress signal or distress call.

50 Seditious, profane, obscene, defamatory, or offensive radiocommunication

No person shall transmit or cause or permit transmission of any radiocommunication of a seditious, profane, obscene, or defamatory nature, or of an offensive nature or meaning.

51 Penalty for contravention of or non-compliance with regulations 48, 49 or 50

Any person who acts in contravention of or fails to comply with any requirement of regulations 48, 59 or 50 commits an offence against these Regulations, and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
94 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

52 Log to be kept

(1) The licensee of every transmitting station shall, unless exempted by
the Superintendent, keep a log record showing the hours during which the station
is in operation, the time of each transmission, the class of emission, the station
called, and the power and the frequency used.
(2) In addition, stations of the maritime mobile service and aircraft stations
shall record such other particulars as may be required from time to time by the
Superintendent.
(3) The log shall be retained for a period of 1 year, and shall be produced
for perusal by an authorised officer whenever required.

53 Unauthorised use of information

Every person who, by virtue of any radio station, has access to any
radiocommunication not intended for his information, shall preserve the secrecy
of that radiocommunication and any information whatsoever derived from it, and
shall not except as authorised in these Regulations make use of that radio-
communication or any information whatsoever derived from it and shall not
reproduce or cause or permit to be reproduced, in a newspaper or elsewhere, or
communicate to any third party, any such radiocommunication or any information
derived therefrom, nor shall the fact of the existence of the radiocommunication
be disclosed.

54 Publication of information

(1) Except with the authority of Cabinet no licensee or other person shall
communicate to a newspaper for publication any radiocommunication by
whatever means received.
(2) This regulation shall not apply to the private correspondence of the
licensee.

55 Penalty for contravention of or non-compliance with regulations 53 or 54

Any person who acts in contravention of or fails to comply with any provision of regulations 53 or 54 commits an offence and shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

56 Copy of telegram

Nothing in these Regulations shall be deemed to prohibit a person duly
authorised in that behalf from giving a copy of any telegram or information relating
to any telegram to the person or persons entitled thereto, or to a properly authorised
official of Government, or to a competent legal tribunal.

57 Restricted radiation devices

Notwithstanding anything in these Regulations, restricted radiation devices
operated subject to the following conditions need not be licensed under these
Regulations –
(a) Operation shall be confined to the frequency range of 10 kHz to
150 kHz, or, in the case of devices used solely for the transmission
of the output of musical instruments or of record reproducing
devices, to the frequency ranges of 10 kHz to 150 kHz and 525 kHz
to 1605 kHz;
(b) The distance over which the operation extends shall not exceed 50
ft; and at this distance the electromagnetic field shall not exceed 15
microvolts per metre in any direction;

Communications 95

(c) No microphone for voice reproduction shall be connected to any such device;
(d) The devices shall be operated with the minimum power necessary to accomplish the desired purpose;
(e) The best engineering principles shall be utilised in the generation of radio frequency energy so as not to cause harmful interference to other radiocommunication services; and in the event that such interference is caused, the operator of the device shall promptly take steps to eliminate the interference;
(f) Any harmful interference that may be experienced from the operation of other restricted radiation devices, or from the operation of any other radiocommunication service, must be tolerated.

58 Control of stations in emergency

(1) If and whenever an emergency has arisen in which it is expedient in
the public interest that Government shall have control over the
radiocommunications of any licensed radio stations, it shall be lawful for any
officer of Her Majesty’s armed forces, or for any other person authorised in that
behalf by Cabinet to take possession of, or to cause the station or any part thereof
to be taken possession of, in the name and on behalf of Her Majesty, and to be
used for Her Majesty’s service, and subject thereto, for such other services as the
said officer or person may deem fit.
(2) In that event, the officer or any person authorised in that behalf by
Cabinet may enter upon any premises at, or on which the station or any part
thereof is installed, and take possession of the station or any apparatus comprising
the station and use the same as aforesaid.
(3) Any such officer or authorised person may in such event as aforesaid,
instead of taking possession of the station, direct and authorise such persons as
he may think fit to assume the control of the radiocommunications of the station,
either wholly or partly, to such extent and in such manner as he may direct, and
any such persons may enter upon any station accordingly, or the said officer or
person authorised by Cabinet in that behalf may –
(a) Direct the licensee or his servants or agents to submit to him, or
any person authorised by him, all messages tendered for
transmission or received by the licensed station, or any class or
classes of any such messages; or
(b) Direct the licensee or his servants or agents to stop or delay the
transmission of any messages, or deliver the same to the said officer
or person or his agent, and generally to obey all such directions
relating to the reception and transmission of messages as the said
officer or person may prescribe; or
(c) Dismantle or order the dismantling of the said station –
and the licensee and his servants or agents shall obey and conform to all such
directions or orders.

59 Inspection of stations

Cabinet or any agent duly authorised by it, may at any time inspect any
station other than a station for the reception of radiocommunications in the
broadcasting service, and may inspect the working and use of any such station,
and for that purpose, or for the purpose of determining whether the qualifications
of any operators employed conform to the requirements of these regulations, may
enter upon any property or premises on which any such station is established,
and the licensee shall afford Cabinet or its agent all reasonable facilities therefor.
96 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

60 Licence, permit or authorisation to be available

Except as otherwise provided in these Regulations, the licensee of any radio
station shall cause the licence, permit, or authorisation, as the case may be covering
the station, to be available at the station at all times for inspection by an authorised
officer.

61 Duplicate copy of licence

(1) A duplicate copy of a licence shall be issued only on production of
satisfactory evidence that the original has been lost, mutilated, or destroyed.
(2) The fee for any duplicate copy of a licence shall be that prescribed in
Schedule 1.

62 Requirements where breach committed against the Act or Regulations

If, in the opinion of the Superintendent or other officer duly authorised by
Cabinet a breach of the Act or of these Regulations has been committed in respect
of the installation or operation of any radio apparatus, the Superintendent or
authorised officer may require the licensee or operator or other person responsible
for the alleged breach to cease to operate or to dismantle the apparatus pending
the determination of Cabinet in respect of the alleged breach, and may take into
custody the whole or part of any such apparatus or in other manner render the
said apparatus inoperative, and any such direction or action shall subsist until
countermanded by Cabinet.

63 Suspension or revocation of licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation

(1) Any licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation issued or enuring under
these Regulations may at any time be suspended or revoked by Cabinet in the
event of misconduct or of a breach on the part of the holder of the International
Radio Regulations, or of these Regulations, or of any conditions, directions, or
rules prescribed by Cabinet for the guidance of operators or for the working of
the licensed station, or of any conditions, directions, or rules subject to which the
licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation was issued, or where it appears to
Cabinet to be in the public interest, or upon the grounds that an emergency has
arisen in which it is expedient that Government shall have control over
radiocommunication.
(2) The licensee shall not be entitled to compensation for any suspension
or revocation of a licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation under this regulation.
(3) Any such suspension or revocation shall be effected by notice serviced
on the licensee, or holder of the permit, certificate, or authorisation, personally, or
sent by registered post addressed to him at his usual or last known place of abode
or business in Niue, or at any address stated in the licence, permit, certificate, or
authorisation or in any application for a licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation,
or publicly notified as provided by regulation 64 and shall be deemed to have
been given, if sent by post, at the time when it would be received at its address in
the ordinary course of registered post, and, if publicly notified, on the day following
the first publication of the notice.
(4) Any licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation revoked under this
regulation shall be forthwith surrendered to Cabinet.

64 Notice of suspension or revocation

Cabinet may publicly notify the suspension or revocation of any licence,
permit, certificate, or authorisation and may give notice to any person of the
suspension or revocation.

Communications 97

65 Failure to surrender licence, permit, certificate, or authorisation

Any person who, without reasonable cause, fails to surrender any licence,
permit, certificate, or authorisation so revoked as aforesaid, after having been
required in writing or otherwise by Cabinet or by any person acting on its behalf,
so to do, commits an offence against these Regulations.

66 Service of notice, request, or consent

(1) Any notice, request, or consent (whether required to be in writing or
not) given by Cabinet under these Regulations may be under the hand of the
Superintendent or other authorised officer of the Department, and may be served
by sending the same in a registered letter addressed to the person concerned at
his office or place of residence for the time being, or, if any such notice, request, or
consent relates to any particular ship station, by delivering the same to the master
or other person responsible for the ship upon which the station is installed.
(2) Any notice to be given by any licensee or any other person under these
Regulations may be served by sending the same in a registered letter addressed to
the Superintendent, Radio Station, Niue.

67 Penalty where no other penalty provided

Any person who acts in contravention of, or commits an offence against,
any of these regulations for which a penalty is not otherwise provided, or who
commits any breach of the conditions of a licence, permit, certificate, or
authorisation of which he is the holder, and for which a penalty is not otherwise
provided, shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
PART 2
OPERATORS CERTIFICATES, AUTHORISATIONS AND EXAMINATIONS

68 Classes of certificates

(1) The classes of operators certificates of competency which may be
granted are the following –
(a) Radiotelegraph operators special certificate;
(b) General radiotelephone operators certificate;
(c) Restricted radiotelephone operators certificate;
(d) Land radiotelephone operators certificate;
(e) Amateur operators certificate.
(2) The fee payable in respect of the entry for the examination for any such
certificate shall be the appropriate fee prescribed in the Schedule 2.

69 Form of certificate or authorisation

Any certificate or authorisation shall be in such form and subject to such
conditions, directions, or rules as Cabinet may approve in that behalf.

70 Terms, conditions and restrictions in connection with certificate or authorisation

Cabinet may, in connection with any certificate of authorisation impose such terms, conditions, and restrictions, not inconsistent with the act or these Regulations, as it thinks fit.

71 Cabinet may refuse to grant an application for an operators certificate or authorisation

Cabinet may refuse to grant an application for any class of operators certificate or authorisation.
98 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

72 Operators certificates issued only to New Zealand citizens

No operators certificate shall be issued to anyone other than a New Zealand
citizen except at the discretion of Cabinet and subject to such terms, conditions,
and restrictions as Cabinet thinks fit.

73 Recognition of Commonwealth operators certificate

The Superintendent may at his discretion recognise as the equivalent of an
operators certificate issued under these Regulations an operators certificate of
similar class issued by a country of the Commonwealth or by the Republic of
Ireland.

74 Conditions for the conduct of examinations

The Superintendent may prescribe the conditions for the conduct of any
examination under these Regulations.

75 Minimum age limit

(1) No operators certificate shall be issued under these Regulations to a
person less than 18 years of age.
(2) (a) An amateur operators certificate may be issued to a person not less
than 16 years of age; and
(b) At the discretion of the Superintendent a restricted radiotelephone
operators certificate or a land radiotelephone operators certificate
may be issued to a person not less than 16 years of age.

76 Examination for radiotelegraph operators special certificate

To qualify for a radiotelegraph operators special certificate a candidate shall
pass the appropriate examination prescribed in the International Radio Regulations
together with a test in the exchanging of traffic, and a practical test to determine
the candidate’s ability to send correctly and to receive correctly by telephone.

77 Endorsement of certificate for radiotelegraph service only

Where a candidate for the examination for a radiotelegraph operators special
certificate is unable to pass a test in sending and receiving messages by telephone
but passes in all other subjects, an appropriate certificate endorsed to apply
exclusively to the radiotelegraph service may be issued.

78 Examination for radiotelephone operators certificate

To qualify for a general or restricted radiotelephone operators certificate a
candidate shall pass the appropriate examination prescribed in the International
Radio Regulations.

79 Examination for land radiotelephone operators certificate

To qualify for a land radiotelephone operators certificate a candidate shall
pass an examination comprising a knowledge of the rules and regulations
applicable to the particular class of station or service in respect of which that
certificate is required.

Communications 99

80 Examination for amateur operators certificates

(1) There shall be 3 grades of amateur operators certificate.
(2) To qualify for a certificate of Grade 1 a candidate shall pass an
examination comprising –
(a) A written examination in the elementary principles of electricity,
radiotelegraphy, and radiotelephony, and in the adjustment and
operation of radio apparatus used in a typical amateur station; and
(b) A knowledge of such of these regulations as are applicable to the
amateur service; and
(c) A morse operating test, both sending and receiving, at a speed of
15 words a minute.
(3) To qualify for a certificate of Grade II a candidate shall pass an
examination comprising –
(a) The examination prescribed in subclause (2)(a) and (b);
(b) A morse operating test, both sending and receiving, at a speed of
12 words a minute.
(4) To qualify for a certificate of Grade III a candidate shall pass an
examination comprising the examination prescribed in subclause (2)(a) and (b).

81 Re-examination

(1) In circumstances in which any such action is deemed to be necessary
or desirable in the public interest, the Superintendent may require any person to
whom any class of operators certificate or authorisation under these Regulations
has been issued to submit himself for re-examination in any or all of the subjects
required for examination for the class of certificates or authorisation concerned.
(2) Where any person fails to submit himself for re-examination in
accordance with this regulation when so required by the Superintendent, or fails
to qualify at the re-examination, the certificate or authorisation issued to that person
may be suspended or revoked for such period as Cabinet shall determine.

82 Recount of marks awarded

(1) In circumstances in which any such action appears desirable the
Superintendent may approve a recount being made of the marks awarded to a
candidate in respect of any written examination prescribed by these regulations.
(2) The fee in respect of each paper for which a recount of marks is
undertaken shall be that prescribed in Schedule 2.

83 Declaration of secrecy

Before any operators certificate or authorisation under these Regulations
is issued a written declaration that he will preserve the secrecy of any
radiocommunication not intended for his information shall be made by the
applicant.

84 Duplicate operators certificate or authorisation

(1) A duplicate copy of an operators certificate or authorisation shall be
issued only on production of satisfactory evidence that the original has been lost,
mutilated, or destroyed.
(2) The fee for any such duplicate copy shall be that prescribed in
Schedule 2.
100 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

85 Types of licences

PART 3
MOBILE STATIONS
The following licences may be issued for the categories of mobile stations mentioned –
(a) Ship station licences for ship stations;
(b) Land mobile station licences for land mobile stations.

86 Limitation applying to ship stations

Except as provided in regulation 88, ship stations are authorised to
communicate only with other stations of the maritime mobile service or with
aircraft stations.

87 Distress calls and distress messages

Mobile stations of the maritime mobile service and aircraft stations shall
accept, with absolute priority, distress calls and distress messages regardless of
their origin and the operator shall immediately convey any such calls and messages
to the master or other person responsible for the ship or aircraft and take such
other action in regard thereto as may be required.

88 Station in distress may use any means at its disposal to attract attention

No provision in these Regulations shall be so construed as to hinder a ship
or aircraft station in distress using any means at its disposal to attract attention,
indicate its position, and obtain assistance.

89 Ship stations licensed to engage in public correspondence

(1) There shall be 4 categories of ship stations licensed to engage in public
correspondence and the category of any such ship station shall be as determined
by Cabinet.
(2) The licensee of a ship station shall provide a service at least during the
hours of service for the category of ship station in which that ship is placed
prescribed as follows –
First category: ship stations of the first category shall maintain a continuous
service;
Second category: ship stations of the second category shall maintain a
service for 16 hours a day;
Third category: ship stations of a third category shall maintain a service for
8 hours a day;
Fourth category: ship stations of the fourth category shall maintain a service
the duration of which may, if not otherwise prescribed by the
International Radio Regulations, be less than that of stations in the third
category.
(3) The class of operator for each category of ship station shall be as
prescribed by the International Radio Regulations for ship stations of the
appropriate category participating in the international public correspondence
service.

90 Ship stations employing radiotelephony not licensed to engage in public correspondence

The minimum qualification to be held by each operator of a ship station employing radiotelephony and not licensed to engage in public correspondence shall be a general radiotelephone operators certificate or a restricted radiotelephone operators certificate as determined by Cabinet.

Communications

101

91 Ship stations employing radiotelegraphy not licensed to engage in public correspondence

Ship stations employing radiotelegraphy and not licensed to engage in public correspondence shall be manned by an operator holding a radiotelegraph operators special certificate or a radiotelegraph operators certificate of higher grade.

92 Accounts, payments and retention of records

(1) The licensee of a ship station open for public correspondence shall keep
full accounts, records and registers of all radiotelegrams transmitted by him. Each
radiotelegram shall be identified by a number and date, full particulars of its place
of origin and of ultimate destination, and such further particulars as the
Superintendent may require to be shown.
(2) The licensee shall preserve all used radiotelegram forms whether
written or printed, and transcripts of radiotelegrams and all other papers relating
thereto, for such period as is prescribed by the International Radio Regulations,
and these shall accompany any account or inquiry submitted by the licensee to
the Superintendent.
(3) The originals of radiotelegrams, and documents relating to
radiotelegams retained by the licensee, shall be held, with all necessary precautions
to maintain privacy as to their contents, for 6 months from the month in which the
accounts were submitted.
(4) The licensee shall pay to the Superintendent, at such times and in such
manner as the Superintendent shall direct, all sums due from the licensee for
radiotelegrams exchanged between the licensed station and coast stations in
accordance with the charges due under the International Radio Regulations as
the Superintendent may direct.
(5) When requested by a coast station for particulars of how or by whom
accounts are to be settled the licensee of the ship station shall, as a matter of regular
procedure, furnish to the coast station the necessary particulars.

93 Documents to be carried by ship stations

Ship stations shall carry such documents relating to the operation of the
station as the Superintendent may require.

94 Ship stations operating in bands between 405 kHz and 535 kHz

Every ship station licensed to use a radiotelegraph installation in the
authorised bands between 405 kHz and 535 kHz shall be able to transmit class A2
or class A2H emissions and receive class A2 and class A2H emissions on the
international calling and distress carrier frequency of 500 kHz.

95 Ship stations operating in bands between 1605 kHz and 2850 kHz

Every ship station licensed to use a radiotelephone installation in the
authorised bands between 1605 kHz and 2850 kHz shall be able to transmit class
A3 or class A3H emissions and receive class A3 and class A3H emissions on the
international calling and distress carrier frequency of 2182 kHz.

96 Ship stations operating in bands between 156 MHz and 174 MHz

Every ship station licensed to use a radiotelephone installation in the
authorised bands between 156 MHz and 174 MHz shall be able to transmit and
receive class F3 emissions on the international calling and safety frequency of
156.80 MHz and on the primary internship frequency of 156.30 MHz.
102 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

97 Ship stations to keep listening watch on 500 kHz

(1) All ship stations licensed to use radiotelegraph installations in the
authorised bands between 405 kHz and 535 kHz shall, during their hours of service,
observe a listening watch on the international distress carrier frequency of 500
kHz twice each hour for 3 minutes commencing at 15 minutes and 45 minutes
past the hour, Greenwich Mean Time.
(2) During these periods all transmissions in the bands between 485 kHz
and 515 kHz except for distress, urgent, or safety transmissions, shall cease.

98 Ship stations to keep listening watch on 2182 kHz

(1) All ship stations licensed to use radiotelephone installations in the
authorised bands between 1605 kHz and 2850 kHz shall, during their hours of
service, observe a listening watch on the international distress carrier frequency
of 2182 kHz twice each hour, for 3 minutes commencing on the hour and half
hour, Greenwich Mean Time.
(2) During these periods all transmissions between the frequencies of 2173.5
kHz and 2190.5 kHz, except for distress, urgency or safety transmissions, shall
cease.

99 Inspection of ship stations

(1) If on inspection under regulation 59, any ship station is found to be not
so equipped or provided for as prescribed in these Regulations, or in the
International Radio Regulations where those Regulations are applicable, a notice
in writing pointing out the deficiency shall be given to the master or licensee of
the station, and a copy of that notice shall be given to an authorised representative
of the Marine Department at the port where the inspection is carried out.
(2) Upon receipt of any such notice the master or other person responsible
for the station shall take immediate steps to rectify the deficiency.

100 Prevention of transmissions from ships in harbour in special circumstances

(1) If and whenever the Government shall deem any such action necessary in the interests of the State, Cabinet may, by public notice, prohibit the use of radio by ship stations in harbour and notify that the provisions of this regulation shall be in force until further notification, and thereafter and until a countermanding notice has been similarly published, the following provisions shall apply in respect of ships entering or in any harbour –
(a) The radio transmitting apparatus shall be rendered inoperative to
the Customs Officer boarding the vessel, and the room or rooms
housing the apparatus shall be locked by the Customs Officer and
the keys handed to the master who shall be responsible for their
custody. The master shall ensure that all portable transmitters are
rendered inoperative by being made subject to the same procedure;
(b) During the stay of the vessel in harbour, access to the radio
transmitting apparatus will be allowed only if it is necessary for
the radio staff to have such access in order to carry out maintenance
work, or other essential duties;
(c) The master shall ensure that no transmissions are made while the
radio transmitting apparatus is so accessible and that the cabin is
relocked as soon as all maintenance work or other essential duties
have been done;

Communications

103
(d) (i) In the case of any foreign ship all radio transmitting apparatus shall be sealed by the Customs Officer boarding the vessel before locking the room or rooms housing the apparatus under paragraph (a) and the master shall be responsible for ensuring that the seals are not broken during the vessel’s stay in harbour;
(ii) Access to radio transmitting apparatus shall be allowed only
for essential maintenance purposes upon the master notifying
the Customs Officer when access is required and the said officer
arranging for the breaking of the seals. The master shall ensure
that no transmissions are made while the apparatus is so
accessible.
(2) An entry shall be made in the ship’s station log of any action taken
under paragraph (1).
(3) No radar installation shall be used by any ship while in harbour except
when the ship is under way and no radio transmissions shall be made at any time
while the ship is in harbour.
(4) If at any time while the provisions of this regulation are in force there is
in respect of any ship in harbour a failure to comply with any of the provisions of
this regulation the owner and master shall be guilty of an offence, and the owner
and master and any other person committing a breach of paragraph (3) shall be
guilty of an offence, and shall be severally liable on conviction to a fine not
exceeding 20 penalty units.

101 Notice of detention of a ship

(1) Whenever Cabinet has reasonable cause to believe or suspect that any
breach of regulation 100 (3) has been committed on board any merchant ship while
in harbour, it may give notice in writing to the Financial Secretary to detain the
ship until the sum of $2,000 or such smaller sum as may be specified in the notice,
has been deposited with the Financial Secretary by or on behalf of the person
liable.
(2) If on receipt of that notice, or at any time within 3 months thereafter, the ship is found within port, the Financial Secretary shall withhold the certificate of clearance of the ship under section 72 of the Customs Act 1966, until and unless the aforesaid sum is deposited with him or the aforesaid notice of detention is withdrawn.
(3) If within 6 months after the date of the offence in respect of which the ship has been detained a conviction for that offence is obtained against any person, the sum so deposited shall be available for the satisfaction of any fine and costs imposed and awarded by the conviction, and the residue, if any, shall be returned to the person by whom or on whose behalf the deposit is made.
(4) If within the period of 6 months aforesaid no such conviction is obtained,
the sum so deposited shall be returned to the person by whom or on whose behalf
it was deposited.
(5) The countermanding of a notice that the provisions of this regulation
are in force shall not affect the liability of any person for an offence committed
before the publication of the countermanding notice.

102 Qualifications of operators of land mobile stations

(1) The minimum qualification to be held by each operator of a land mobile
station shall be a radiotelegraph operators special certificate or a land radio
telephone operators certificate as the case may require.
(2) If the frequency of emission of a radiotelephone transmitter is above 30
MHz no operators certificate shall be required.
104 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

103 Penalty where no other penalty provided

Any person who commits a breach of any of the regulations in this Part for
which a penalty is not otherwise provided in this Part commits an offence and
shall be liable on conviction to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units for each such
breach.

104 Types of licences

PART 4
LAND STATIONS
Land station licences may be issued for the following categories of land stations –
(a) Coast stations;
(b) Base stations.

105 Coast stations operating in bands between 405 kHz and 535 kHz

Every coast station licensed to use a radiotelegraph installation in the
authorised bands between 405 kHz and 535 kHz shall be able to transmit class A2
or class A2H emissions and receive class A2 and class A2H emissions on the
international calling and distress carrier frequency of 500 kHz.

106 Coast stations operating in bands between 1605 kHz and 2850 kHz

Every coast station licensed to use a radiotelephone installation in the
authorised bands between 1605 kHz and 2850 kHz and capable of transmitting on
the international calling and distress carrier frequency of 2182 kHz shall be able to
transmit class A3 or class A3H emissions and receive class A3 and class A3H
emissions on that carrier frequency.

107 Coast stations operating in bands between 156 MHz and 174 MHz

Every coast station licensed to use a radiotelephone installation in the
authorised bands between 156 MHz and 174 MHz shall be able to transmit and
receive class F3 emissions on the international calling and safety frequency of
156.80 MHz.

108 Coast stations to keep listening watch on 500 kHz

(1) All coast stations licensed to use a radiotelegraph installation in the
authorised bands between 405 kHz and 535 kHz shall, during their hours of service,
observe a listening watch on the international distress carrier frequency of 500
kHz twice each hour for 3 minutes, commencing at 15 minutes and 45 minutes
past the hour, Greenwich Mean Time.
(2) During these periods all transmissions in the bands between 485 kHz
and 515 kHz, except for distress, urgency or safety transmissions, shall cease.

109 Coast stations to keep listening watch on 2182 kHz

All coast stations licensed to use a radiotelephone installation in the
authorised bands between 1605 kHz and 2850 kHz shall, during their hours of
service, observe a listening watch on the international distress carrier frequency
of 2182 kHz twice each hour for 3 minutes, commencing on the hour and half
hour, Greenwich Mean Time. During these periods all transmissions between the
frequencies of 2173.5 kHz and 2190.5 kHz, except for distress, urgency, or safety
transmissions, shall cease.

Communications

105

110 Qualifications of operators of coast stations

The minimum qualification to be held by each operator of a coast station
shall be a radiotelegraph operators special certificate or a restricted radiotelephone
operators certificate as the case may require.

111 Qualifications of operators of base stations

(1) The minimum qualification to be held by each operator of a base station
shall be a radiotelegraph operators special certificate or a land radiotelephone
operators certificate as the case may require.
(2) Where the frequency of emission of a radiotelephone transmitter is
above 30 MHz no operators certificate shall be required.

112 Scope of licences

PART 5
FIXED STATIONS
A fixed station licence may be issued for a fixed station and shall specify fixed points between which radiocommunications are authorised for that station.

113 Qualifications of operators

(1) The minimum qualification to be held by each operator of a fixed station
shall be a radiotelegraph operators special certificate or a land radiotelephone
operators certificate, as the case may require.
(2) Where the frequency of emission of a radiotelephone transmitter is
above 30 MHz no operators certificate shall be required.

114 Scope of licences

PART 6
AMATEUR STATIONS
Amateur station licences shall authorise the establishment of stations in the amateur service.

115 Persons to whom licences may be issued

(1) Amateur station licences shall be issued only to the holders of amateur
operators certificates, and shall be issued only to individuals.
(2) In the case of any society having as its sole or principal object the pursuit
by its members of an interest in amateur radio a licence may be issued to an
authorised official of the society as trustee therefor.

116 Qualifications of operators

(1) No person shall operate an amateur station unless he holds an amateur
operators certificate nor shall the licensee of any such station cause or permit any
person not being the holder of such a certificate to operate the said station.
(2) Any person not ordinarily resident in Niue who, in the country in which
he is ordinarily resident, is the holder of an amateur station licence or an amateur
operators certificate may operate an amateur station under the direct supervision
of the licence.
106 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

117 Issue of authorisation to non-citizen

(1) Cabinet may and subject to such terms, conditions, and restrictions as
it may prescribe in that behalf, issue an authorisation to permit any person who is
not a New Zealand subject, and who is licensed by his Government as an amateur
radio operator, to operate the amateur station licensed by his Government, in
Niue.
(2) No authorisation shall be issued under paragraph (1) unless Cabinet is satisfied that the applicant’s Government is willing to make reciprocal arrangements for the benefit of amateur radio operators holding amateur operators certificates issued by Cabinet.
(3) Cabinet may refuse to issue any authorisation under this regulation notwithstanding that the applicant’s Government may be willing to make reciprocal arrangements as aforesaid, or may suspend or revoke an authorisation under this regulation.
(4) The holder of an authorisation under this regulation shall, subject to
the terms and conditions of the authorisation, have in Niue all the rights and
obligations of the holder of an amateur operators certificate issued by Cabinet.

118 Temporary operation at a different address

An amateur station licence shall authorise the establishment of an amateur
station at the licensee’s usual address or, during such times as the licensee may be
temporarily absent from his usual address, the establishment by him of a station
at a different address.

119 Communication permitted with other amateur stations only

Except in the case of emergency or where otherwise approved by the
Superintendent, amateur stations shall be used for the purpose of communicating
with other stations of the amateur service only.

120 Handling of third party messages prohibited

Licensees of amateur stations shall not engage in radiocommunication for
any third party.

121 Licensees not to engage in radiocommunication for hire or material compensation

Licensees of amateur stations shall not engage in radiocommunication for hire or material compensation, direct or indirect, paid or promised.

122 Limitation on class of message

All radiocommunications from amateur stations, whether by speech or in
Morse code, shall be conducted in plain language and shall be limited to messages
of a technical nature relating to radio experiments and to remarks of a personal
character for which, by reason of their unimportance, recourse to the public
telecommunications service is not justified.

123 Transmission of news, entertainment, or recordings prohibited without prior approval

Except with the prior written approval of the Superintendent, the licensee of an amateur station shall not transmit matter by way of national or international news, or any matter by way of public entertainment, or which by virtue of its significance would be of concern, to the public generally, or any body of the public, and shall not transmit recordings of any kind.

Communications

107

124 Power permitted

(1) Except as may be authorised by Cabinet, the power permitted to be
used in transmitting apparatus at an amateur station shall not exceed 150 watts
direct current input to the final radio frequency stage or stages delivering power
to the aerial.
(2) In those cases where the power input varies with the modulating
component the measurement of the direct current input shall be made with the
transmitter fully modulated and using meters of a type in which full-scale current
causes 63 percent of full-scale reading in one quarter of a second or less.

125 Harmful interference to broadcast reception

(1) In the event of the operation of an amateur station causing harmful
interference to broadcast reception by receiving apparatus which, in the opinion
of the Superintendent or other authorised officer, is of reasonable selectivity, the
licensee of the amateur station concerned shall when so required by the
Superintendent or other authorised officer, forthwith cease to operate the station
on the frequency or frequencies which cause interference until the interference is
removed.
(2) Should the complete elimination of the interference be impossible, the
operation of the station may be resumed only with the permission of the
Superintendent or other authorised officer on such conditions and at such times
as may be prescribed.
––––––––––––––––––––––––

Fees Payable in Respect of Certificates Issued Under Part 2 of the Radio Regulations

1972

1 For examination

(a)

Radiotelegraph operators special certificate

$2

(b)

General radiotelephone operators certificate

$2

(c)

Restricted radiotelephone operators certificate

$1.50

(d)

Land radiotelephone operators certificate

$1

(e)

Amateur operators certificate

$0.75

(f)

Morse operating only

$0.50

2

For each examination paper in respect of which a recount of

marks is undertaken

$0.50

3

For a duplicate copy of a certificate

$0.50

108 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

TELEPHONE REGULATIONS 1968

SR 1968/25 – 1 April 1968

1

Title

30

Inspection of equipment

2

Interpretation

31

Precautions to prevent damage or injury

32

Damage to equipment

PART 1

33

Cleansing of telephone

TELEPHONE EXCHANGE SERVICES

34

Interference with equipment

3

Telephone services subject to Regulations

35

Transmission of communications or

4

Applications for service

musical items

5

Service connection fee

36

Service discontinued for illegal or improper

6

Annual rates and other charges

use of instrument

7

Charges for telegrams

37

Interruptions of service

8

Refusal or discontinuation of service

38

Overloaded lines

9

Business stations

39

Removal of plant

10

Residential station used for a business

11

Poles at cost of subscriber

PART 2

12

Telephone directory to be supplied

MISCELLANEOUS TELEPHONE SERVICES

13

Superintendent may alter or change

40

Temporary telephone service

number

41

Joint use of telephone

14

Use of telephone exchange lines

42

Removals

15

Party line service

43

Change of apparatus

16

Regrouping of subscribers on party lines

44

Transfer of connection

17

Duration of conversation over party line

45

New occupier to obtain transfer

18

Calls over party line exceeding reasonable

46

Subscriber not to sell service

use of line

47

Change in intercommunicating system

19

Rating system for annual charges

48

Extension telephones

20

Rate charge

49

Private branch exchange

21

System of payment

22

Failure to pay charges

PART 3

23

Defaulter in respect of charges

GENERAL PROVISIONS

24

Service obtained by defaulter in other name

50

Government may enter into contracts

25

Reconnection fee

51

Penalty for offences

26

Refund of rental

27

Adjustment of rental

SCHEDULES

28

Telephone directory listings

29

Supply of equipment

1 Title

These are the Telephone Regulations 1968.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“contract” means the agreement which is executed when application is
made for telephone service;
“Department” means the Telecommunications Department and includes
the Superintendent, and any officer of the Department acting in the
premises;
“exchange” means a departmental telephone exchange consisting of one
or more offices containing switching apparatus by means of which
intercommunication between the various subscriber ’s stations
connected therewith may be given;

Communications

109
“extension station” means a subsidiary station normally having access to the exchange line, with or without the intervention of the main station; “individual line” means a subscriber ’s line connecting one subscriber ’s
station with a telephone exchange;
“main station” means the subscriber ’s main telephone apparatus on which
incoming calls are normally received;
“party line” means a line connecting two or more subscribers’ stations with
a telephone exchange;
“prescribed charge” means the charge stated in Schedule 1 for the service
referred to in that Schedule;
“rental” means the amount which Cabinet charges for the use of the
telephone equipment which forms part of a telephone exchange
connection;
“subscriber” means the person who is recognised by Cabinet as the lessee
of a telephone exchange connection;
“Superintendent” means Director of the Telecommunications Department
of Government; and includes any officer of the Niue Public Service
acting for the time being in the place of the Superintendent, whether
during any vacancy in that office or otherwise.
(2) Notwithstanding the use in these Regulations or in any contract or other
document of any of the words “lease”, “lessee”, and “rental”, or any similar words,
no subscriber shall at any time be deemed to be in possession or entitled to
possession of any line, telephone instrument, apparatus, or equipment, the
property of the Government, except such as is from time to time for the time being
installed within the buildings of the subscriber ’s premises, and all other lines,
apparatus, and equipment to which any contract relates shall be deemed to remain
in the possession of the Government but to be the subject of a right in the subscriber
to have the use and benefit of the same to the extent and in the manner provided
by the contract and by these Regulations, and not further or otherwise.
PART 1
TELEPHONE EXCHANGE SERVICES

3 Telephone services subject to Regulations

All telephone services furnished by the Department shall be subject to these
Regulations and to all amendments and extensions thereof and substituted
regulations at any time in force, and it shall be a condition implied in every contract
for telephone services, heretofore or hereafter made by the Department that the
contract shall be so subject.

4 Applications for service

(1) Applications for telephone exchange service shall be made in writing
on the form of application and contract supplied for that purpose.
(2) Any application made on behalf of a partnership or a company shall be
signed by one of the partners or by an authorised officer of the company
respectively.
(3) Except where special services are sought, the application and contract
shall be in form 1 in Schedule 2.
110 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

5 Service connection fee

(1) A service connection fee prescribed in Schedule 1 shall be payable in
respect of each new or additional connection (main station), except in the case of
a temporary connection as provided for in regulation 40.
(2) (a) Cabinet may, in special circumstances, waive or reduce the fee.
(b) The fee shall be an initial charge only, and shall be payable at the
time of application for service.

6 Annual rates and other charges

(1) Telephone services shall be subject to the annual rates and other charges
appropriate to the classes of service provided as prescribed in Schedule 1, and
shall be for such minimum period as the Department may determine at the time
of application, and shall be continued thereafter until the subscriber gives notice
in writing that the service is to be discontinued or until the Department
discontinues the service.
(2) Every contract for the hire of instruments shall be deemed to be for the
minimum period referred to therein and thereafter until discontinuance of the
service as aforesaid, subject to the rights of the Department to discontinue the
service, notwithstanding that the minimum period may not have expired.

7 Charges for telegrams

In addition to being liable for the payment of any telephone charges in
respect of the telephone exchange connection leased by him, a subscriber shall be
liable for the charges in respect of all telegrams telephoned from his telephone
station to a telegram office for onward transmission.

8 Refusal or discontinuation of service

The Superintendent may –
(a) Refuse to comply with an application for connection with any
telephone exchange system, or for the transfer of any existing
telephone service or for the construction of any telephone line;
(b) Disconnect a subscriber ’s telephone from one exchange should he
consider such action desirable;
(c) Discontinue giving service at any exchange if other suitable
arrangements can be made for serving the subscribers;
(d) Instead of refusing absolutely to comply with any application,
accede thereto only upon such conditions as to security, nature of
service (including type of apparatus) to be afforded, special
minimum period of contract, or other conditions as he may think
fit.

9 Business stations

For the purposes of assessment, a subscriber ’s station shall be deemed to
be a business station –
(a) If it is installed in premises that are used as a warehouse, shop,
office, boardinghouse, or otherwise wholly or in part for business
purposes, including a private residence so used;
(b) If in any other way it bears prima facie evidence of being used for
business purposes, or, in the opinion of the Superintendent is so
used.

Communications

111

10 Residential station used for a business

Whenever in the opinion of the Superintendent a station assessed as a
residential station is used for a business, the Superintendent may require payment
at the rate prescribed for a business station from the date when in his opinion it
was so used.

11 Poles at cost of subscriber

All poles in excess of one on private roads or private property shall be
supplied, erected, and renewed whenever in the opinion of the Superintendent
renewal is advisable, at the cost of the subscriber or subscribers concerned, except
that no charge shall be made in this respect –
(a) When the pole line forms part of a route to be used in serving other
subscribers; or
(b) When the pole line is used for other departmental purposes; or
(c) When there is in the opinion of the Superintendent an alternative
route by public road; or
(d) In exceptional cases where the Superintendent so directs.

12 Telephone directory to be supplied

For the rates prescribed for telephone exchange stations the Department
shall supply one copy of the telephone directory for each telephone, and provide
and maintain all necessary exchange equipment, subscribers’ lines, and one
telephone per station.

13 Superintendent may alter or change number

No subscriber shall have any right to or interest in any particular number,
and the Superintendent may alter or change any number at his discretion.

14 Use of telephone exchange lines

(1) Except in cases in which the preservation of human life or the protection
of public property may be involved, or as otherwise provided in these Regulations,
telephone exchange lines shall be used only by the subscriber, his family, guests,
and employees, and exclusively on his or their affairs.
(2) On breach of this regulation the Superintendent may cause the
telephone service to be discontinued.

15 Party line service

Party line service shall be provided to the extent that the equipment available
in the telephone exchange permits, and then only when the subscribers desiring
to be connected with the same line can in the opinion of the Department
conveniently be served from the same point of distribution.

16 Regrouping of subscribers on party lines

The Superintendent may regroup the subscribers on party lines, and may
make additional connections to party lines, without the consent of the existing
subscribers.

17 Duration of conversation over party line

A conversation over any party line shall not exceed six minutes in duration
if the line is required by any other person.
112 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

18 Calls over party line exceeding reasonable use of line

When in the opinion of the Superintendent the number of calls originated
or received by any subscriber connected with a party line precludes a reasonable
use of the line by the other parties, the Superintendent may require the subscriber
either to rent an individual line or to be transferred to a line with which there will
be smaller number of parties connected.

19 Rating system for annual charges

For every subscriber ’s main station there shall be payable an annual charge
covering an unlimited number of local calls and fixed according to –
(a) Whether the station is a business station or residence;
(b) Whether the station is on an individual line, or a party line.

20 Rate charge

Subject to regulation 15, and unless otherwise specified in these Regulations,
individual, 2, 3, 4 and 5 party line service shall be furnished to stations at the rates
prescribed in Schedule 1.

21 System of payment

(1) All prescribed annual charges for telephone exchange service shall be
payable in advance by equal half-yearly instalments on the first days of the half-
yearly periods commencing on the first days of April and October.
(2) On the commencement of service or of any extended or additional
service a proportionate part of the annual charges from the date on which the
service is made available to the next ensuring half-yearly day of payment shall be
paid within 7 days after the first mentioned date.

22 Failure to pay charges

If any subscriber fails for 7 days after written demand made upon him to
pay any instalment of annual charges or any other charges due by him under
these Regulations, the Superintendent may cause the telephone service to be
discontinued.

23 Defaulter in respect of charges

If a subscriber becomes a defaulter in respect of any charges due under the
conditions of contract, or any other telephone charges due under these Regulations,
he shall not be furnished with telephone service of any kind until he has discharged
his liability to the Department.

24 Service obtained by defaulter in other name

If the Superintendent is satisfied that any service is being obtained either
in his own or any other name by a person who is, in the opinion of the
Superintendent, a defaulter in connection with any telephone service furnished
by the Department, Cabinet may cause the telephone service to be discontinued.

25 Reconnection fee

(1) In the event of any subscriber ’s service being discontinued under
regulation 22, a reconnection fee, prescribed in Schedule 1 in addition to all other
amounts due, shall be payable by the subscriber before the service is restored.
(2) If the instruments at the subscriber ’s premises have been removed, or
if any portion of the circuit has been dismantled, a request for application for
restoring the circuit shall be treated as an application for a new connection.

Communications

113

26 Refund of rental

Should a subscriber discontinue the renting of a service during the currency
of a period for which rental has been paid in advance, a refund of rental shall be
granted in respect of the unexpired term if it exceeds seven days, but no refund
shall be granted in respect of any portion of the minimum period originally
provided for in the contract.

27 Adjustment of rental

(1) In the event of the number of subscribers’ stations connected with a
line being reduced by the withdrawal of one or more of the subscribers, the
amended rates prescribed in respect of the remaining stations shall take effect
from the first day of the next half yearly period for which accounts are to be issued.
(2) In the event of the number of subscribers’ stations connected with a
line being increased, the new or additional subscriber shall pay rental from the
date of their connection at the rates prescribed for the amended number of stations
connected with the line; but no alteration shall be made in the rentals of the original
stations until the first day of the following month.
(3) Notwithstanding paragraphs (1) and (2), a reduction in the number of
subscribers’ stations connected with a party line shall not affect the rental of a
subscriber until the expiration of the minimum period originally provided for in
the contract.

28 Telephone directory listings

For each subscriber ’s main station one free entry will be published in the
telephone directory to contain not more than one line of print and to consist of the
name or firm name of the subscriber or his nominee, his business (in the case of a
business station), his address, and the telephone number.

29 Supply of equipment

(1) All lines , telephone instruments, equipment, and fittings in connection
with the telephone exchange system, except where otherwise provided by these
Regulations, shall be supplied and erected by the Department, and, except with
the authority of the Department, no person other than an employee of the
Department provided with proper means of identification shall interfere with or
make any additions or alterations to any such electric line, instrument, equipment,
or fitting under the Department’s control.
(2) In the event of any such interference by any unauthorised person, the
subscriber concerned shall be liable to have his service discontinued without
prejudice to any other liability that may be incurred.

30 Inspection of equipment

Employees of the Department provided with proper means of identification
shall at all reasonable times have free access to the premises of any subscriber for
the purpose of inspection, removal, or replacement of the departmental apparatus
therein.

31 Precautions to prevent damage or injury

The Superintendent shall take reasonable precautions to prevent damage
or injury to subscribers or their premises from fire or other cause by reason of the
installation of telephone apparatus, but neither the Superintendent nor the
Government shall be liable for any damage or injury that may arise from the failure
of any such precautions.
114 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

32 Damage to equipment

(1) In the event of any instrument, battery, or equipment on the premises
of a subscriber being lost, wholly destroyed, or partially damaged through any
means whatever (other than fair wear and tear), the subscriber shall pay to the
Department on demand, the cost to the Department of replacing or repairing the
instrument, battery, or equipment; but no charge shall be made in respect of any
instrument, battery, or equipment accidentally destroyed or damaged by fire,
earthquake, or other inevitable catastrophe.
(2) This regulation shall apply notwithstanding that there has been no
negligence on the part of the subscriber or any person for whom he is responsible,
and notwithstanding that the loss, destruction, or damage may have arisen from
some cause not due to the act or default of the subscriber.

33 Cleansing of telephone

Any person who, not being the subscriber or an employee of the subscriber,
cleanses, without the written permission of the Department, the mouthpiece or
earpiece of any telephone the property of the Department, for fee or reward,
commits an offence against these Regulations.

34 Interference with equipment

(1) No person shall damage or destroy or interfere with any line, telephone
instrument, apparatus, or equipment being the property of the Government,
whether supplied under this Part or under any other Part or otherwise, and whether
or not in the possession or control of that person, or cause or suffer the same to be
damaged or destroyed or interfered with, or put the same or cause or suffer the
same to be put to any improper use.
(2) For the purpose of this regulation, interference includes the removal
from its regular place of any instrument, apparatus, or equipment unless supplied
as intended to be portable; and also includes the removal or detachment of a part
of any instrument, apparatus, or equipment unless supplied as intended to be at
the discretion of the user detachable; and also includes the adjustment,
maintenance, repair and modification of any instrument, apparatus, or equipment,
and the incorporation therein or connection therewith or addition thereto of any
additional or other instrument, apparatus, or equipment.
(3) Every person who commits a breach of this regulation commits an
offence against these Regulations.

35 Transmission of communications or musical items

(1) No person shall use any telephone instrument, or cause or suffer any
telephone instrument to be used, for the transmission of communications of a
nature calculated to annoy or irritate any person.
(2) No person shall without the authority of Cabinet, use any telephone
instrument, or cause or suffer any telephone instrument to be used, for the purpose
of transmitting musical items, whether they be derived from direct vocal or
instrumental performance or from radio broadcast transmission or from
mechanically operated musical instruments or reproducing instruments or
otherwise.
(3) Every person who commits a breach of this regulation commits an
offence against these Regulations.

Communications

115

36 Service discontinued for illegal or improper use of instrument

Cabinet may cause the telephone service of any subscriber to be
discontinued –
(a) If any person is convicted of a breach of regulations 34 or 35
involving the use of a telephone instrument belonging to the
telephone service; or
(b) If, in the opinion of Cabinet, a telephone instrument belonging to
that telephone service has been used in a manner contrary to
regulations 34 or 35;
(c) If, in the opinion of Cabinet, a place of business or house or other
premises where a telephone instrument belonging to that telephone
service is situated is or are used for any illegal, immoral, or improper
purpose.

37 Interruptions of service

(1) Neither Cabinet nor any officer of the Department nor the Government
shall be liable for any action, claim, or demand for compensation for interruption
of telephone service arising from any cause whatsoever.
(2) When a subscriber moves from one part of a village to another, and the
Department is unable to provide him with telephone service within seven days,
an allowance shall be made of the amount of the rental corresponding to the
number of days during which the subscriber is deprived of telephone service.

38 Overloaded lines

With a view to reducing the number of ineffective calls due to overloaded
lines, the Superintendent may require any subscriber on whose line or lines the
number of such calls exceeds 25 percent of the number of effective incoming calls
to rent an additional circuit, in default of which telephone service may be
discontinued.

39 Removal of plant

(1) Whenever telephone service is discontinued pursuant to any of these
Regulations, it shall be lawful for employees of the Department provided with
proper means of identification to enter the premises in which are installed any
wires, instruments, apparatus, or equipment of the Department and to remove
the same from the premises, without prejudice to the subscriber ’s liability for any
unpaid rental or other charges due and owing or occurring under these
Regulations; and no liability or claim for damages on the part of any person shall
be against Cabinet or any officer or employee of the Department or the Crown,
whether by reason of the discontinuance notice, entry, or removal, or on any
ground.
(2) Any person who, without lawful justification, refuses to deliver to any
employee of the Department any wires, instruments, apparatus, or equipment of
the Department to the possession of which he is not for the time being entitled
commits an offence against these Regulations, without prejudice to any other
liability that may be incurred.
116 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 2
MISCELLANEOUS TELEPHONE SERVICES

40 Temporary telephone service

(1) When telephone service is desired for a shorter term than the period
determined under regulation 6, the service may be granted conditionally on the
applicant making application in writing in form 2 in Schedule 2 and paying, in
addition to the estimated cost involved in establishing the service, the cost of labour,
transport of labour, transport of material, and value of any material which is
perishable or is so dealt with in making the installation as in the opinion of the
Department not afterwards to be conveniently usable, a charge based on the annual
rate for a permanent connection, with a minimum charge as for 6 months.
(2) The estimated cost of establishing the service and the minimum charge
shall be payable before the service is provided.
(3) (a) In the event of the subscriber ultimately deciding to have the
temporary service converted to an ordinary permanent one, the
usual contract shall be executed, and the prescribed charge shall
take effect from the date of completion of the contract;
(b) In any such case the cost of making the connection shall be refunded,
but the usual service connection fee must be paid.
(4) Temporary extension telephones may be installed on payment of the
usual installation charges as for temporary connections.
(5) Rental shall be charged at the rate prescribed in Schedule 1.

41 Joint use of telephone

(1) Any subscriber may with the approval of the Superintendent and upon
payment of the fee prescribed in Schedule 1 obtain the right to allow the use of his
telephone instrument to any person occupying an office in the same building, or
occupying the same private residence, within which the telephone instrument is
placed.
(2) (a) In any such cases the subscriber shall make application in writing
in form 3 in Schedule 2 and be responsible for all service charges
and toll charges, but may charge to the person or persons having
the joint use of the telephone any portion of the charges.
(b) The fee applicable to joint use entitles each of the joint users to the
insertion of his name in the telephone directory.
(3) If any extension telephones are involved the charges for those
instruments shall be determined by the Superintendent.

42 Removals

(1) Subject to the approval of the Department, subscribers may have their
telephones and apparatus removed to other premises, or the position of their
telephones and apparatus altered, upon giving sufficient notice in writing and
paying the fees prescribed in Schedule 1.
(2) In the event of a subscriber removing from or giving possession of the
premises in which the telephone is situated without making arrangements
approved of by the Superintendent for the removal of the telephone or
discontinuance of the service, Cabinet may cause the service to be discontinued.

Communications

117

43 Change of apparatus

Subject to the approval of the Department, a subscriber may obtain a change
of apparatus upon making application in writing, including an agreement to pay
any additional rental involved and upon payment of the installation charges
prescribed in Schedule 1.

44 Transfer of connection

(1) A fee, as prescribed in Schedule 1, shall be payable for the transfer of
an existing exchange connection whether the transfer necessitates a removal or
not. The application for transfer shall be in form 4 in Schedule 2 and all outstanding
toll fees shall be paid before the transfer is granted.
(2) Any rental held by the Department in respect of the period subsequent
to the date of transfer shall be credited to the account of the transferee.
(3) The transfer of a telephone involving its removal shall be granted only
in exceptional circumstances or where the transfer is to take place before the
expiration of the minimum period provided for in the contract, and on payment
of the usual removal charges.

45 New occupier to obtain transfer

A person who has entered into the occupation of any premises having
telephone service shall not be entitled to make use of the telephone until he has
obtained a transfer; and, if any such person makes use of the service before
obtaining a transfer, he shall be deemed to have assumed the service, and (without
prejudice to any liability of the subscriber or any right or power of the Department)
shall be liable for all amounts owing in respect of the service of the time when he
entered into occupation of the premises, as well as amounts which become payable
in respect of any use of the telephone after that time.

46 Subscriber not to sell service

(1) A subscriber shall not sell or offer for sale his telephone service; nor
shall a subscriber accept a monetary offer for the transfer of his telephone.
(2) If in Cabinet’s opinion any subscriber violates this regulation, or if any
telephone connection is obtained by the violation of this regulation, Cabinet may
cause the telephone service in respect of which the offence is committed to be
discontinued.
(3) Nothing in this regulation shall prevent the transfer of a telephone
service to a new or existing subscriber, with the consent of the Department, upon
or in connection with a bona fide change in the occupancy of the premises in
which the service is installed.

47 Change in intercommunicating system

(1) Subject to the approval of the Department, and on making application
in form 2 in Schedule 2, including an agreement to pay the cost of the labour and
incidental expenses involved in installing the necessary apparatus, telephones
and the associated wiring, a subscriber may obtain telephones and switching
facilities for intercommunication between various positions in the same premises.
(2) The charges for intercommunicating services are as prescribed in
Schedule 1.
(3) (a) In this regulation and in regulation 48 the term “same premises”
includes various buildings detached from one another but within
the same boundaries as the main premises and forming part of the
same establishment; but does not include separate dwellings on
the same property.
118 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(b) The Superintendent may, however, authorise, in special circumstances the installation of extension stations involving wires crossing a public street or road or another person’s property.

48 Extension telephones

(1) Extension telephones and other miscellaneous equipment required
within the same building or upon the same premises (as defined in regulation 47
(3) as the main station shall be furnished and maintained by the Department upon
payment of the installation and rental charges prescribed in Schedule 1.
(2) An extension telephone shall not be installed in a subscriber ’s business
premises if the main station with which it is associated is paid for as a residence
station.

49 Private branch exchange

(1) The equipment of a private branch exchange shall include a switchboard
or switching apparatus of sufficient capacity to provide accommodation for all
exchange lines and extension stations required by the subscriber, together with
the necessary batteries, ringing devices, fitting, and one telephone or operator ’s
set for each switchboard position.
(2) The cost of power for charging and recharging any secondary batteries
associated with a private branch exchange shall be borne by the subscriber.
PART 3
GENERAL PROVISIONS

50 Government may enter into contracts

Nothing in these Regulations shall affect the power of the Government to
enter into contracts for the provision of special equipment and wiring arrangements
in cases not provided for by these Regulations.

51 Penalty for offences

Every person who commits an offence against these Regulations is liable
to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE

SCHEDULE 1

PART A – ANNUAL RATES FOR STATIONS (REG. 20)

Class of station

Business Rate

$

Residence Rate

$

Individual

24.00

15.00

Two party

18.00

13.00

Three party

16.00

11.00

Four party

14.00

9.00

Five party (or more)

12.00

7.00

PART B – TEMPORARY TELEPHONE SERVICE (REG. 40)

(1) Main station – A weekly rate at one fifty-second of annual rate plus 50
percent, with a minimum charge as for two weeks or whichever is the higher, and
a minimum charge of 50c for each succeeding week or fraction thereof.

Communications

119
(2) Extension station – 15c a week or fraction thereof with a minimum charge of 30c.
(3) The applicant must pay also the estimated installation and dismantling costs in respect of labour and transport, and the value of any irrecoverable material or material rendered unfit for further use, with a minimum charge of $1. If the connection is later made permanent a service connection fee becomes payable, and the foregoing costs are refunded less the value of any temporary material rendered unusable in so doing.

PART C – JOINT USE OF TELEPHONE (REG. 41)

Additional annual rental –

$

Business main station

6.00

Residence main station

4.00

PART D – EXTENSION STATIONS (REG. 48)

$

Extension telephone 5.00

PART E – CHANGE OF APPARATUS (REG. 43)

Description of Change

For One

Change

For Each Additional

Change in

Same Premises at

Same Time

(a) Change to another telephone

(b) Conversion of a manual extension telephone

from non-intercommunicating to

intercommunicating

(c) Change of extension bell or other small item

of miscellaneous equipment where no additional

wiring is required

$

2.00

4.00

2.00

$

0.50

1.00

1.00

PART F – INTERCOMMUNICATING SERVICE (REG. 47)

(1) The subscriber is charged the cost of the labour and expenses involved for –

(a) Providing a new extension station or system;

(b) Adding to or altering an existing system;

(c) Changing to another system;

(d) Replacing a system by another of greater capacity;

(e) Installing switchboards at the request of the subscriber, in excess of the number

PART G – MISCELLANEOUS FEES AND CHARGES

$

(1)

Service connection fee (reg. 4)

6.00

(2)

Reconnection fee (reg. 25)

3.00

(3)

Transfer fee (reg. 44)

1.00

(4)

After-hours connection

5.00

(5)

Extension bell

1.00

(6)

Push-button and buzzer

1.50

120 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

PART H – REMOVAL OF TELEPHONES (REG. 42)

From One Room To Another

From One Position To Another in the Same Room

(a) Main telephone

(b) Ordinary extension telephone

(c) Extension bell or other miscellaneous

equipment

(d) Intercommunicating extension

telephone

$

2.00

2.00

2.00

Labour and incidental expenses

$

1.00

1.00

1.00

Labour and incidental expenses

(3) In the case of a removal or an alteration which is not covered above, or the disturbance of apparatus, equipment, or wiring by building alterations or renovations, the subscriber is charged with the labour and incidental expenses.

–––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 2

Form 1 Reg. 4

TELEPHONE EXCHANGE SERVICE

FORM OF APPLICATION AND CONTRACT

To the Director of Telecommunications,

ALOFI

APPLICATION

I/WE, (Mr) (Mrs)(Miss) [Full name], hereby request that you arrange for the installation

of a telephone on my/our behalf at

in accordance with the undermentioned particulars.

I/WE tender herewith the prescribed service connection fee of $6.00.

Particulars of Service Desired

(Indicate requirements thus)

Classification of service Type of service

Business Individual

Residence Party line

Type of fitting

Desk

Wall

Communications

121

CONTRACT

For the use of the telephone instruments, and for the telephone service, I/WE agree

to pay the prescribed charges in advance as from the date of connection, and to be bound

by all regulations from time to time in force respecting the hire or use of Government

telephones, and to perform and conform to all conditions contained in any such

regulations.

And I/WE further agree to hire the said instruments and line for the terms of

....................................... from the date of connection.

Signature of applicant ............................... Signature of witness .....................

Occupation ................................................. Occupation ....................................

Address ....................................................... Address ..........................................

Date .............................................................. Date .................................................

Reg. 40 Form 2

TELEPHONE EXCHANGE SERVICE

Application for Auxiliary Telephone Service, Miscellaneous Equipment

or for Removal of Existing Telephones

To the Director of Telecommunications

ALOFI

I hereby request that you [Insert particulars of service required], in respect of which I

agree to pay the prescribed charges and estimated costs amounting to ..........................

[Delete if not applicable] And I further agree to pay half yearly in advance, as from

the date of installation, the annual rates prescribed for any auxiliary services or

miscellaneous equipment applied for hereon.

Signature of subscriber .......................... Occupation ............................................... Address .................................................... Signature of witness ............................... Occupation ............................................... Address .................................................... Date ...........................................................

Reg. 41 Form 3

TELEPHONE EXCHANGE SERVICE

Application for Joint Telephone Service

To the Director of Telecommunications

ALOFI

I/WE, ........................................................... desire permission for M .........................

who is occupying a portion of the (residential) (business) premises in which my/our

telephone No. ....................................................... is situated, to have the joint use of the said

telephone for which I/WE agree to pay, in addition to the present rental, the prescribed

charges for this class of telephone service.

It is desired that the extra listing in the telephone directory be as follows…

Signature of subscriber ..........................

Occupation ...............................................

Address ....................................................

Signature of witness ...............................

Occupation ...............................................

Address ....................................................

Date ...........................................................

122 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

I agree to the telephone directory listing set out below:

Signature of person requiring joint

use of telephone ......................................

Occupation ...............................................

Address ....................................................

Signature of witness ...............................

Occupation ...............................................

Address ....................................................

Date ...........................................................

Reg. 44 Form 4

TELEPHONE EXCHANGE SERVICE

Application for Transfer of Exchange Connection

To the Director of Telecommunications

ALOFI

I /WE ............................................... hereby make application for the transfer to me/

us of the telephone exchange connection at present in the name of .................................

in respect of which rental has already been paid in advance to the [Date], and tender

herewith the transfer fee of $1.

For the use of the instruments and for the telephone service I/WE agree to pay

half-yearly in advance, as from ......................................................... the prescribed charges,

and to be bound by all regulations from time to time in force respecting the hire or use of

Government telephones, and also to perform and conform to all conditions contained in

any such regulations.

And I/WE further agree to hire to the said instruments and line until the

................................................................... 19 .................. being the date of expiration and the

term of the contract signed by .....................................

It is requested that the connection be listed in the directory thus –

Signature of applicant ............................

Occupation ...............................................

Address ....................................................

Signature of witness ...............................

Occupation ...............................................

Address ....................................................

Date ...........................................................

I agree to the transfer of the connection.

Signature of transferor* ..........................

*If the signature of the new transferor cannot be obtained, application must be made for a new connection.

123

CUSTOMS

CUSTOMS REGULATIONS 1968

SR1968/89 – 10 October 1968

22 Inward report of aircraft

23 Unshipment of goods

23A Removal of goods

Entry of Imported Goods

24 Entries for imported goods

25 Part packages

26 Entry of goods imported in aircraft or ships

26A Certain goods exempt from entry

26B Condition of entry of certain goods

27 Entry not to refer to goods imported in

more than one ship or aircraft

28 Passengers’ effects not to be landed without

permission of Customs

29 Effects not accompanying passengers

30 Declaration by passengers

31 When entry to be made

32 Sight entries

33 Pro forma transshipment

Entry of Goods for Export

34 Export entries for goods subject to the

control of the Customs

35 Export entries for goods not subject to the

control of the Customs

36 Exemption from entry for export

37 Landing certificates for exported goods

Departure of Ships and Aircraft

38 Certificate of clearance

39 Outward report of ships

40 Outward report of aircraft

Stores for Ships and Aircraft

18

Expected time of arrival

45-46

19

Unauthorised persons not to board or leave

47

Entry of and payment of duty on stores

ships

subject to duty

20

Unauthorised persons not to board aircraft

21

Inward report of ships

124 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

PART 4

WAREHOUSES

Special Provisions as to Manufacturing

Warehouses

48 Production of sugar in manufacturing

warehouse

49 Manufacture in a manufacturing

warehouse of goods containing alcohol

50 Manufacture or processing of lubricating

oils in a manufacturing warehouse

General Provisions as to Warehouses

51 Annual licence fees for warehouses

52 Measurement of warehouses

53 Marking of warehoused goods

54 Receipt for goods deposited in a warehouse

55 Repacking in warehouse

56 Entry and clearance of warehoused goods:

minimum quantities

57 Temporary removal of warehoused goods

58 Clearance of warehoused goods

59 Export or removal of warehoused goods

60 Goods delivered for export or removal, and

not shipped

61 Rewarehousing

PART 5

DUTIES

Duties of Excise

62 Value of goods made in a manufacturing

warehouse

Valuation of Goods

63 Ad valorem declaration

64 Form of invoice

65 Costs of appeals

66 Value for duty of goods re-exported from

Australia

67 Cases to which regulation 66 applies

68-79 –

Assessment and Recovery of Duty

80 Strength of spirits

81 Application to retest spirits

82 Minimum duty collectable

83 Essences, condensations, concentration

84-85 –

86 Samples allowed free of duty

Refunds and Remissions of Duty

87 Duty paid in error

88 Goods of faulty manufacture

89 Goods damaged or deteriorated in

condition

90 Warehoused goods diminished in value

91 Goods destroyed, pillaged or lost

92 Materials used in manufacture of agricultural implements, machinery, ships, and boats

93 Security for duty on goods temporarily imported

Drawback

94 When drawback allowed

95 Conditions governing drawback in special

cases

96 Manager may waive non-compliance with

conditions

97 Entry for drawback

98 Reimportation of goods exported under

drawback

PART 6

TOBACCO

99 Returns of tobacco, and materials other

than tobacco, used in manufacture

100 –

PART 7

METHYLATED SPIRIT

General Provisions as to Methylation

101 Minimum strength for spirit

102 Samples of substances for purposes of

methylation

103 Standard for wood naphtha

104 Standard for pyridine

105 Standard for methyl violet dye

106 Manufacture, use, and sale of methylated

spirit

107 Completely denatured spirit

108 Containers of denatured spirit to be

labelled

Methylated Spirit (Pyridinised)

109 Ingredients

110 Manufacture and disposal

111 Purchase and use

Methylated “Finish”

112 Ingredients

113 Sale or disposal

Methylated Spirit Without Pyridine (W.P.)

114 Ingredients

115 Manufacture and disposal

116 Purchase and use

117 Record of manufacture, purchase, sale and

use

118 Place of security

119 Partially manufactured products

120 Manufacture under supervision

Customs 125

Spirit Methylated with Phenol

121 Ingredients

122 Manufacture and disposal

123 Provisions as to methylated spirit W.P. to

apply to spirit methylated with phenol

Miscellaneous Provisions

124 Other formulas

125 Revocation of approval or permit

126 Fee for officer ’s time

PART 8

POWERS OF OFFICERS OF CUSTOMS

127 Taking of samples

128 Use of samples

129 Disposal of samples

130 Examination, measurement of goods

PART 9

AGENTS AND CARRIERS

Agents

131 Approval of employees as agents

132 Customs agents’ licences

133 Customs agent’s licence (Individuan( �/p>

133A Customs agent’s licence (Generan( �/p>

133B Customs agent’s licence (Restricted)

133C Application for licences

133D Refusal of licence

133E Variation of licence

133F Revocation or suspension of licence

133G Appeals

134 Security by agents

135 Licence fee

Customs Carriers

136 Customs carriers

137 Revocation of carrier ’s licence

138 Security by carriers

PART 10

FORFEITURES

139 Notice of seizure

140 Notice to dispute forfeiture

PART 11

MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

Declarations

141 Form of declarations

142 Verification of information by declaration

Special Provisions as to the Post Office

143 “Postal packet” defined

144 When entry for postal packets not

required

145 Powers of officers of Post Office

146 Disposal of postal packets by Postmaster

147 Several postal packets may be treated as

a single package

148 Person forwarding packets may be

treated as importer

149 Exemption from entry

Miscellaneous Provisions

150 Persons engaged in business

151 Offences and penalties

SCHEDULES

1 Title

These are the Customs Regulations 1968.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Customs Act 1966 ;
“Customs Acts” means the Customs Acts as defined in section 3 of the
Customs Acts 1966;
“prescribed form” means a form prescribed by the Revenue Manager and
a reference to a numbered form is a reference to a form so prescribed
and numbered.
(2) Expressions defined in the Act have the meanings so defined.
126 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

3 [Spent]

PART 1
ADMINISTRATION

Forms

4 Compliance with directions in forms

Where a prescribed form contains, by way of note or otherwise, a direction
or indication of any requirement of the Customs as to –
(a) The number of copies of the document to be tendered;
(b) The nature or form of the information to be furnished;
(c) The colour of the paper on which the form is to be printed;
(d) Any action, either by way of signing a form of declaration or
otherwise, to be taken by the person concerned in the transaction
in which the document is used or by his authorised agent; or
(e) Receipts to be signed by officers of transport services or other
persons in proof that the goods described in the form have been
received for carriage or for any other purpose –
the requirement so indicated shall be deemed to be prescribed, and shall be
complied with by the person concerned in the transaction or his authorised agent.

5 Particulars as to statistical units and classifications

(1) Where in respect of any item of the Customs Tariff an indication appears
in that column of the Tariff headed “Unit”, there shall be shown on any prescribed
form used in relation to the entry of any imported goods included in or classified
under any such item the quantity of goods so entered, expressed in terms of the
unit so indicated.
(2) Where, on any form prescribed for the entry of goods for export, the
statistical classification of goods is required to be shown, there shall be shown the
information indicated in respect of the particular class of goods in the publication
entitled “The Statistical Classification of Exports” and published from time to time
by the Customs.

6 Manager may require additional copies of forms or additional particulars The Manager may require copies of any prescribed form in addition to the number indicated on the form, and he may require to be shown on any form information additional to that prescribed if he deems the furnishing of the additional information to be necessary for the administration of the Customs Acts

or for the preparation of statistical reports and returns.

7 Manager may accept document substantially in prescribed form

The Manager may accept instead of any prescribed form, other than a
prescribed form of declaration, any document that is substantially in accordance
with the prescribed form.

8 Size of forms

Forms prescribed under these Regulations shall be of such sizes as the
Manager may approve.

9 Forms to be completed in typewriting or in ink

(1) Except where the Manager otherwise permits, all original documents
presented to the Customs shall have the necessary particulars typewritten or
inserted in ink, but copies may be prepared by carbon or other copying process.

Customs 127

(2) The Manager may refuse to accept any document that is not readily legible or is prepared otherwise than in accordance with paragraph (1).

Miscellaneous Provisions

Customhouse at any time not later than 4pm during the working hours of the
Customs as prescribed in regulation 12 (b).

12 Working hours

(1) The working hours of the Customs shall be –
(a) Boarding Inspectors’ Officers: On Mondays to Fridays inclusive,
from 8am to 5pm;
(b) All other offices: On Mondays to Fridays inclusive, either from 8am
to 4.35pm or 8.30am to 5.05pm as the Manager directs in respect of
each office.
(2) In respect of any office situated at a Customs airport the working hours
for the purposes of regulation 14 shall be those determined by the Manager in
respect of that office.

13 Fees for officers’ time during working hours

(1) Where, in any regulation under the Customs Acts, provision is made
for a charge to be paid to the Manager for the attendance of any officer of Customs
during the working hours of the Customs to perform or supervise any operation,
the charge shall be at the rate of $1.33 an hour or portion of an hour.
(2) The Manager may authorise a charge at the rate prescribed in paragraph
(1) to be made by the Manager for the attendance of any officer during the working
hours of the Customs to perform or supervise any operation in respect of which
provision for the charge is not made elsewhere in any regulation under the Customs
Acts.

14 Fees for officers’ time outside working hours

(1) Whenever, for the purpose of carrying out any provision of the Customs
Acts, any Customs officer is required to attend at any time outside the working
hours of the Customs, the master or owner of any ship, pilot in command or owner
of any aircraft, importer, exporter, remover, brewer, or other person concerned
shall pay, in such cases as may be determined by the Manager, a charge calculated
according to the following rates in respect of that attendance –
(a) For attendance on any Customs holiday, $2.66 an hour or portion
of an hour;
(b) For attendance outside the working hours of the Customs on other
days $2 an hour or portion of an hour.
(2) A minimum charge of $5.32 shall be payable for the attendance of any
officer on any Customs holiday.

15 Expenses of officers

Where in respect of any attendance for the purpose of performing or
supervising any act required or permitted by the Customs Acts any travelling or
other expenses are incurred or to be incurred by any officer of Customs, the
Manager may require those expenses to be defrayed by the master or owner of
any ship, pilot in command or owner of any aircraft, importer, exporter, remover,
brewer, or other person concerned.
128 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 2
GENERAL PROVISIONS AS TO ENTRIES

Control of the Customs

16 Notice of delivery for home consumption

(1) The authority for the delivery of goods from the control of the Customs
for home consumption shall be –
(a) In the case of warehoused goods, whether imported or not, in form
26A; and
(b) In the case of other imported goods, including goods deemed to
have been entered in accordance with regulation 29, in form 13B.
(2) In all cases, the authority shall be signed by the Manager or other proper
officer.
(3) Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing provisions of this regulation,
in the case of –
(a) Goods imported in any aircraft or ship and deemed to have been
entered in accordance with regulation 26; or
(b) Goods imported by post and deemed to have been entered in
accordance with regulation 143 –
the authority for the delivery of the goods shall be in such form or manner as the
Manager may approve.

General Provisions as to Entries

17 Cancellation or amendment of entry

(1) Every person applying to the Manager for permission to cancel or
amend an entry shall state his reason for desiring the cancellation or amendment.
(2) The Manager may require any such application and statement of reasons
to be in writing or to be verified by declaration.
PART 3
IMPORTATION, EXPORTATION, REMOVAL WITHIN NIUE

Arrival of Ships and Aircraft

18 Expected time of arrival

(1) The master, owner, or agent of every ship arriving in Niue shall, not
later than 12 hours before the estimated time of arrival of the ship at the first port,
inform the Manager at that port of the estimated time of arrival.
(2) The pilot in command, owner, or agent of every aircraft arriving in
Niue shall, not later than 2 hours before the estimated time of arrival of the aircraft
at the first Customs airport, inform the Manager of the estimated time of arrival.

19 Unauthorised persons not to board or leave ships

(1) Except as provided in this regulation, or except in the case of urgent
necessity due to a marine casualty or other like emergency, no person other than a
pilot or other person necessary for the navigation of the ship shall, without the
permission of an officer of Customs, board or leave any ship arriving from any
country outside Niue until the inspection and examination of the passengers and
crew have been completed.
(2) The restrictions imposed by paragraph (1) shall not apply to any of the
following persons acting in the exercise of their powers or functions under any
enactment –
(a) Any officer of Customs;
(b) The Port Health Officer and his assistants;
(c) A constable;
(d) An agriculture inspector.

Customs 129

20 Unauthorised persons not to board aircraft. Restriction on leaving

(1) Except as provided in this regulation, or except in the case of urgent
necessity due to a aircraft accident or other like emergency, no person other than
a person necessary for the operation of the aircraft shall, without the permission
of an officer of Customs, board any aircraft arriving from any country outside
Niue.
(2) The restrictions imposed by paragraph (1) shall not apply to any of the following persons acting in the exercise of their powers or functions under any enactment –
(a) Any officer of Customs;
(b) A Medical Officer of Health;
(c) A constable;
(d) An agriculture inspector.
(3) The proper officer of Customs may, if he considers it necessary for the
due administration of the Customs Acts, require all or any of the passengers or
crew of any aircraft arriving from any country outside Niue to remain on board
the aircraft until the inspection and examination of the aircraft and its passengers
and crew have been completed.

21 Inward report of ships

(1) The inward report to be made in respect of every ship, except a coastal
ship, arriving at any port shall –
(a) In the case of any such ship arriving from any country outside Niue
consist of –
(i) An arrival manifest in form 1, and such particulars of
passengers and crew as the Manager may require; and
(ii) A search list in form 2; and
(iii) A store list in form 3; and
(iv) [Revoked]
(b) –
(c) In the case of each such ship include such other documents and
further particulars as the Manager may require.
(2) The master or owner of any vessel, except a coastal ship, arriving at
any port shall make an inward report of the ship within one day after arrival at
that port, or within such longer period as may be permitted by the Manager in
any particular case.

22 Inward report of aircraft

(1) In respect of every aircraft arriving at any Customs airport for the first
time on any journey from any country outside Niue the inward report shall consist
of –
(a) –
(b) A general declaration in form 64; and
(c) Such particulars of the passengers as the Manager may require;
and
(d) A cargo manifest in form 66; and
(e) A crew and search list in form 67; and
(f) A bonded stores list in form 68; and
(g) Such other documents or further particulars as the Manager
requires:
Provided that, if the aircraft is not disembarking passengers or discharging cargo,
unaccompanied baggage, or stores, the general declaration shall so state, and a
passenger list and a cargo manifest shall not be required.
130 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(2) In respect of every aircraft arriving at any Customs airport after an inward report has first been made in accordance with paragraph (1) and carrying any goods brought from any country outside Niue, and not yet delivered from the control of the Customs, the inward report shall consist of –
(a) A general declaration in form 64; and
(b) Such other documents and further particulars as the Manager may
require.
(3) The pilot in command or owner of the aircraft shall make such inward
report on arrival at any Customs airport or within such period thereafter as may
be permitted by the Manager in any particular case.

23 Unshipment of goods

The Manager ’s permit to unship or land goods which are subject to the
control of the Customs, or which would become subject to that control if unshipped
or landed, shall be in form 20 and shall be issued subject to the conditions set forth
there.

23A Removal of goods

The Manager’s permit to remove from any wharf, Customs airport, Customs
containerbase, or examining place any goods subject to the control of the Customs
shall be in form 20A, and shall be issued subject to the conditions set forth there.

Entry of Imported Goods

24 Entries for imported goods

Entries for imported goods shall be in the following forms –
(a) For home consumption temporarily and under security for
subsequent re-exportation, in form 34;
(b) For home consumption otherwise, in forms 13 and 13A;
(c) For warehousing, in forms 14 and 14A;
(d) For export, in form 15;
(e) For removal in accordance with regulation 33, in form 16;
(f) For removal otherwise, in form 15.

25 Part packages

(1) Except with the permission of the Manager, entry shall not be made of
a portion only of the contents of any package of imported goods.
(2) This regulation shall not apply in the case of the entry of separate
portions of a package previously passed on a sight entry.

26 Entry of goods imported in aircraft or ships

(1) Except when required by the Manager, it shall not be necessary for any
importer to make entry for home consumption of any goods imported in any
aircraft or ship if the total current domestic value of the goods imported by him in
that aircraft or ship is less than $20.
(2) Any goods to which paragraph (1) applies shall be deemed to have
been entered for home consumption when application is made by the importer
for their delivery.

Customs 131

26A Certain goods exempt from entry

Except as otherwise required by the Manager, and subject to the conditions
set out in regulation 26B –
(a) All bulk cargo containers; and
(b) All wagons, trolleys, and wheeled pallets specially designed for
the handling of bulk cargo containers; and
(c) All lighters imported temporarily for the purpose of facilitating the
discharging and loading of cargo which is being imported or
exported,
may be imported or exported without entry.

26B Condition of entry of certain goods

The condition under which goods may be imported or exported without
entry pursuant to section 54A of the Act is that the importer shall enter into and
comply with a covenant –
(a) In form 36 in the case of goods described in regulation 26A(a) or
(b); and
(b) In form 38 in the case of goods described in regulation 26A(c), and
(c) In form 37 in the case of pallets.

27 Entry not to refer to goods imported in more than one ship or aircraft

Except where the Manager in any special case permits, each entry shall
relate to goods imported in only one ship or aircraft.

28 Passengers’ effects not to be landed without permission of Customs

Imported goods being personal baggage or household or other effects (all
of which are referred to in regulations 29 and 30 as effects) shall not be unshipped
or landed from any ship or aircraft or removed from any wharf or examining
place without the permission of an officer of Customs.

29 Effects not accompanying passengers

When effects do not accompany passengers, they shall be deemed to have
been entered for home consumption if a declaration in form 19 or form 19A, the
case may require, has been made and delivered to the Manager or other proper
officer.

30 Declaration by passengers

The Manager may require any passenger arriving in Niue to make a
declaration in form 18 for sea passengers and form 18A for air passengers with
respect to the effects accompanying them.

31 When entry to be made

Subject to section 55 (1) of the Act, entry of goods shall be made, at the port
of arrival of the goods, within 21 working days after their arrival.

32 Sight entries

Sight entries shall be in form 17.
132 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

33 Pro forma transshipment

(1) When entry for removal is made of all the goods shown on the manifest
of any ship or aircraft for any port, the following shall be inserted on the entry
instead of the marks and numbers and the number and description of the packages
and the goods, namely: “All cargo for................................................, as set forth on the part manifest
of the report made and declared to… at the Customhouse this day, and having its
pages numbered ...........................to ...........................”.
(2) For the purposes of this regulation and of regulation 24 (e) all such
goods shall be deemed to have arrived at their port of discharge as soon as the
master or pilot in command has reported the importing ship or aircraft in
accordance with section 45 of the Act.

Entry of Goods for Export

34 Export entries for goods subject to the control of the Customs

Entry for export of goods subject to the control of the Customs, if not
required to be made in forms 15 or 16 or 27 or 34 or 35, shall be made in form 22.

35 Export entries for goods not subject to the control of the Customs

Entry for export of goods not subject to the control of the Customs shall be
in form 22, and shall be made within 6 days after loading on the exporting ship or
aircraft.

36 Exemption from entry for export

(1) In such cases as may be approved by the Manager, it shall not be
necessary for any exporter to make entry for export of any goods.
(2) Any goods to which paragraph (1) applies shall be deemed to have
been entered for export when the bill of loading or air consignment note or air
waybill, as the case may be, is presented to the Manager or other proper officer.

37 Landing certificates for exported goods

The certificate referred to in section 67 (2) of the Act shall be given by the
Manager or principal officer of Customs or other responsible Government official
at the port of destination of the goods, and shall be in form 21.

Departure of Ships and Aircraft

38 Certificate of clearance

Every certificate of clearance shall be in form 8.

39 Outward report of ships

The outward report required to be made in respect of every ship, except a
coastal ship, about to depart from any port shall –
(a) In the case of a ship departing for any country outside Niue consist
of an outward manifest of cargo and particulars of passengers and
crew in form 10, or in such other form as the Manager may permit;
(b) In the case of a ship departing coastwise, consist of a manifest in
form 4; and if the ship has not on board any cargo shipped in any
country outside Niue, the manifest shall be amended by deleting
all reference to such original cargo.

Customs 133

40 Outward report of aircraft

(1) In respect of every aircraft departing from any Customs airport for any
country outside Niue, the outward report shall consist of –
(a) A general declaration (in duplicate) in form 64; and
(b) A passenger manifest (in duplicate) in form 65; and
(c) A crew and search list in form 67; and
(d) Such other documents or further particulars as the Manager
requires.
(2) If the aircraft is not embarking passengers or loading cargo or
unaccompanied baggage the general declaration shall so state, and the passenger
manifest shall not be required.

Stores for Ships and Aircraft

41 Classes of ships’ stores exempt from duty

The following classes of goods (in regulations 42 to 44 referred to as ships’
stores) shall be deemed to be stores within the meaning of section 78 of the Act –
(a) Goods for use or consumption on board ships or aircraft;
(b) Goods to be fitted into ships or aircraft.

42 Request for ships’ stores

The request for ships’ stores shall be in form 12.

43 Receipt for ships’ stores

(1) A receipt for all ships’ stores received on board a ship or aircraft shall
be given by or on behalf of the master of the ship or the pilot in command of the
aircraft.
(2) In the case of stores of the class referred to in regulation 41 (b) the master
or pilot shall satisfy the Manager that the stores have actually been fitted into the
ship or aircraft specified.

44 Ships’ stores shipped under drawback

(1) Ships’ stores shall not be shipped, under drawback, unless the Manager
is satisfied that they cannot conveniently be obtained from a licensed warehouse.
(2) The entry of goods shipped as ships’ stores under drawback shall be
made in form 35 and in the manner prescribed in regulation 94.

45-46 ––

47 Entry of and payment of duty on stores subject to duty

(1) Entry of ships’ stores as required by section 79 (2) of the Act shall be in
forms 13 and 13A.
(2) Entry shall be made and duty paid before clearance of the ship or aircraft
from the first port of arrival after the consumption of the stores.
134 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 4
WAREHOUSES

Special Provisions as to Manufacturing Warehouses

48 Production of sugar in manufacturing warehouse

(1) Pursuant to section 80 of the Act the production of sugar in a
manufacturing warehouse is permitted.
(2) In this regulation, “sugar” means sugar of any kind, of any degree of
polarisation, and includes invert sugar, invert syrup, treacle, molasses, golden
syrup, and other products obtained from the refining of sugar.

49 Manufacture in a manufacturing warehouse of goods containing alcohol

(1) Pursuant to section 80 of the Act, the manufacture of goods in which
alcohol is a necessary ingredient is permitted in a manufacturing warehouse.
(2) For the purposes of this regulation, alcohol means ethyl alcohol, neutral
spirit, any other potable spirit, methyl alcohol, and denatured spirit of a kind
permitted by the Manager to be used in a manufacturing warehouse.

50 Manufacture or processing of lubricating oils in a manufacturing warehouse

Pursuant to section 80 of the Act, the processing or manufacture of petroleum oils from substances, other than used lubricating oil, is permitted in a manufacturing warehouse.

General Provisions as to Warehouses

51 Annual licence fees for warehouses

Annual licence fees for warehouses shall be according to the appropriate
scale set forth in the Second Schedule together with any additional sum that may
be payable pursuant to section 85 of the Act.

52 Measurement of warehouses

(1) The cubic content of any warehouse subject to the fee set forth in Part 3
of Schedule 2 shall be the measurement of the internal space.
(2) The measurement of the internal space shall not include –
(a) Any space in excess of 3 metres in height on each floor or storey; or
(b) Any space in the roof above the level of the wall plates.

53 Marking of warehoused goods

Before any goods are removed to any warehouse, or immediately after their
arrival in any warehouse in such cases as the Manager may permit, the goods or
their external containers shall be plainly and permanently marked in such manner
as the Manager requires.

54 Receipt for goods deposited in a warehouse

The receipt for goods deposited in a warehouse shall be in form 14A.

55 Repacking in warehouse

(1) The following classes of goods may be repacked in a warehouse into
packages containing not less than the following quantities –
Cigarettes, cigars or snuff: 9kgs
Other manufactured tobacco: 16kgs
Wine or spirits in bulk: 60 litres
Other goods: Into such packages that the duty payable thereon will be not
less than $4;

Customs 135

Provided that goods intended for ships’ stores may be repacked into packages containing such quantities as the Manager approves.
(2) Goods repacked in a warehouse shall be labelled or marked in such manner as the Manager approves.
(3) Application for permission to repack goods in a warehouse, and entry for goods repacked in a warehouse, shall be in form 24.

56 Entry and clearance of warehoused goods: minimum quantities

The following are the minimum quantities of the classes of goods
enumerated below that may be entered for warehousing or cleared from a
warehouse on any one of the relevant forms of entry –
Beer in cases: 5 cases
Spirits in cases: 1 case
Bitters, cordials, or liqueurs: 1 case
Other kinds: 4 cases
Spirits in bulk: 60 litres
Wine in cases: 5 cases
Wine in bulk: 60 litres
Cigarettes, cigars or snuff: 9kgs
Other manufactured tobacco: 16kgs
Other goods: in such quantities that the duty payable will be not less than
$4:
Provided that goods may be cleared for export for ships’ stores or otherwise, in
such quantities as the Manager approves.

57 Temporary removal of warehoused goods

Application for the temporary removal of warehoused goods shall be made
in form 25.

58 Clearance of warehoused goods

Entries for the clearance of warehoused goods shall be in the following
forms –
(a) For home consumption, in forms 26 and 26A; (b) For export, in forms 27, 27A and 27B;
(c) For removal, in forms 28, 28A and 28B or in form 29, as the case
requires.

59 Export or removal of warehoused goods

Whenever required by the Manager, warehoused goods shall, before entry
for export or removal for warehousing elsewhere, be remeasured, reweighed,
regauged, retested, or re-examined.

60 Goods delivered for export or removal, and not shipped

Goods delivered from a warehouse for export or removal and not shipped
shall be returned to the warehouse or accounted for to the satisfaction of the
Manager.

61 Rewarehousing

Application for rewarehousing, and entry for goods rewarehoused, shall
be in form 24.
136 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 5
DUTIES

Duties of Excise

62 Value of goods made in a manufacturing warehouse

Where any goods, not specified in the Third Schedule to the Act, are made
in a manufacturing warehouse, and the duty payable thereon is an ad valorem
duty, the value of the goods shall be the factory cost of those goods, as defined in
regulation 73, with the addition of 10 percent of such cost.

63 Ad valorem declaration

Valuation of Goods

The declaration in respect of the invoice for and the value of imported goods subject to ad valorem duty shall be the declaration prescribed as part of forms 13,
14 and 34.

64 Form of invoice

Every invoice for goods imported into Niue shall, except where not so
required by the Manager, be in form 55, and shall be accompanied by a certificate
of value in form 56 or in that form modified as may be necessary to suit the
requirements of any provision of the Act and as approved by the Manager.

65 Costs of appeals

The reasonable costs incurred by the Customs in an unsuccessful appeal
under section 142 of the Act shall be fixed by the Minister of his delegate as follows –
(a) The actual disbursements of the Customs; and
(b) Such travelling or other expenses of any delegates (including officers
of Customs) as may be approved; and
(c) Fees payable to any delegates (not being officers of Customs) at
such rate as the Minister determines.

66 Value for duty of goods re-exported from Australia

The current domestic value of goods, not being the produce or manufacture
of Australia, but imported from Australia into Niue may in the cases specified in
regulation 67 be assessed at an amount exceeding by 10 percent the current
domestic value of those goods in the country from which they were exported to
Australia, at the time of their exportation to Australia.

67 Cases to which regulation 66 applies

(1) Assessment of the current domestic value of any goods in accordance
with regulation 66 may be made in all cases which comply, to the satisfaction of
the Manager with the following conditions –
(a) That the goods are imported into Niue in the condition in which
they were imported into Australia;
(b) That the original invoice which was produced to the Customs upon
entry of the goods in Australia, or a copy of that original invoice or
of so much thereof as relates to the goods, certified by a competent
Customs authority in Australia to be a true copy in whole or in part
of the original invoice, is produced to the proper officer of Customs
in Niue together with the invoice for the goods as required by section
137 of the Act;
(c) That the original invoice, or copy thereof, shows the current
domestic value of the goods in the country from which they were
exported to Australia, at the time of that exportation;

Customs 137

(d) That the original invoice has been certified in accordance with the requirements of the Australian or Niue Customs regulations, or otherwise to the satisfaction of the Manager;
(e) That the current domestic value of the goods, if assessed under regulation 66, would be not less than their current domestic value assessed independently of that regulation if, at the time of their importation into Niue from Australia, they were imported into Niue directly from the country from which they were exported to Australia;
(f) That the deductions (if any) provided for in section 136 (5) of the Act are made only in respect of sums paid or payable on the goods in the country from which they were exported to Australia.
(2) If the importer satisfies the Manager that the current domestic value of any goods as assessed in accordance with regulation 66 is greater than their current domestic value assessed independently of that regulation, then the Manager may assess the current domestic value of the goods independently of that regulation.

68-79 ––

Assessment and Recovery of Duty

80 Strength of spirits

The strength of spirits shall be ascertained by the use of Sikes’s hydrometer,
or by such other means as the Manager approves.
equivalent of dutiable goods obtainable from any essences, condensations, concentrations, or preparations of dutiable goods shall be the factor ascertained by reference to the Department of Scientific and Industrial Research by which the quantity of any such essence, condensation, concentration, or preparation as aforesaid must be multiplied to arrive at the quantity or equivalent required.

84-85 ––

86 Samples allowed free of duty

Samples of goods subject to the control of the Customs may, on written
application by the owner, be delivered free of duty in such quantities as may be
determined by the Manager either generally or in any particular case.
138 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Refunds and Remissions of Duty

87 Duty paid in error

The conditions on which refund of duty paid in error may be allowed in
accordance with section 172 of the Act are as follows –
(a) The applications shall be in such form as the Manager may require;
(b) The importer shall, at his own expense, produce to the Manager or
other proper officer such evidence as is required to verify the fact
of error and the amount of duty paid in error.

88 Goods of faulty manufacture

(1) The conditions on which, and the extent to which, refund or remission
of duty may be allowed in accordance with section 173 of the Act on goods of
faulty manufacture are as follows –
(a) Application in such form as the Manager may require shall be made
within 3 months after delivery of the goods from the control of
Customs;
(b) The importer shall, at his own expense, produce such reasonable
evidence as the Manager requires that any fault in the goods
occurred in the course of their manufacture, and that the fault
prevents or is likely to prevent the goods from being used for the
purpose for which they were designed;
(c) The goods shall be made available for examination if required by
the Manager or other proper officer;
(d) Refund or remission of duty on the goods shall be allowed in
proportion to the extent to which the Manager is satisfied that they
have diminished in value by reason of the fault in manufacture:
Provided that refund or remission of the full duty on the goods
shall not be allowed by the Manager unless the goods have been
destroyed to his satisfaction.
(2) Notwithstanding anything in paragraph (1), the Manager may, in special
cases, grant refund or remission of duty on goods of faulty manufacture even
though application has not been made within 3 months after delivery of the goods
from the control of the Customs.

89 Goods damaged or deteriorated in condition

(1) The conditions on which, and the extent to which, refund or remission
of duty may be allowed in accordance with section 173 of the Act on goods
damaged or deteriorated in condition are as follows –
(a) Application shall be made in form 11 within 28 days after delivery
of the goods from the control of the Customs;
(b) The importer shall, at his own expense, produce such reasonable
evidence as the Manager requires as to the nature, cause, or extent
of the damage or deterioration in condition of the goods;
(c) The goods shall be made available for examination if required by
the Manager or other proper officer;
(d) Refund or remission of duty on the goods shall be allowed in
proportion to the extent to which the Manager is satisfied that they
are damaged or deteriorated in condition:
Provided that the full duty shall not be refunded or remitted unless
the goods have been destroyed to the satisfaction of the Manager.
(2) Notwithstanding paragraph (1), the Manager may, in special cases, grant
refund or remission of duty on goods damaged or deteriorated in condition even
though application therefor has not been made within 28 days after delivery of
the goods from the control of the Customs.

Customs 139

90 Warehoused goods diminished in value

(1) Application for remission of duty under section 174 of the Act shall be
made in such form as the Manager approves.
(2) Remission of duty under section 174 of the Act shall be allowed on
warehoused goods liable to ad valorem duty in the cases in which and to the extent
to which the duty that would be payable on the goods, if exported from the country
of exportation to Niue at the time at which application for remission is made, is
less than the duty payable on the value of the goods as determined by section 136
of the Act:
Provided that in no case shall the full duty by remitted unless the goods
have been destroyed to the satisfaction of the Manager.
(3) The importer shall, at his own expense, produce such reasonable
evidence as the Manager requires as to the cause or the extent of the diminution in
value.

91 Goods destroyed, pillaged or lost

(1) The conditions on which refund or remission of duty may be allowed
in accordance with section 175 of the Act on goods destroyed, pillaged, or lost are
as follows –
(a) Application for remission of duty on goods in a warehouse which
have been lost through diminution in quantity or weight in a
warehouse shall be made in form 30;
(b) Application for refund or remission of duty on other goods
destroyed, pillaged, or lost shall be made, in form 11, within 28
days after delivery of the goods from the control of the Customs;
(c) Goods in a warehouse shall not, except with the special approval
of the Manager be regauged, remeasured, or reweighed before entry
for home consumption, unless they have been stored in the
warehouse for a period of at least 3 months;
(d) The importer shall at this own expense, produce such reasonable
evidence as the Manager requires as to the cause or extent of any
such destruction, pillage, or loss.
(2) Notwithstanding paragraph (1), the Manager may, in special cases, grant
refund or remission of duty on goods destroyed, pillaged or lost even though
application therefor has not been made within 28 days after delivery of the goods
from the control of the Customs.

92 Materials used in manufacture of agricultural implements, machinery, ships and boats

Refund of duty under section 180 of the Act on materials used in the manufacture in Niue of agricultural implements, machinery, ships, and boats may be made subject to the following conditions –
(a) Application shall be made in form 32;
(b) The applicant shall, at his own expense, produce evidence as to the
payment of duty on the materials, the time and place of
manufacture, and such other particulars as the Manager requires;
(c) Except with the special permission of the Manager refund shall not
be granted unless application is made within 2 months after the
date of completion of manufacture of the agricultural implements,
machinery, ships, or boats.
140 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

93 Security for duty on goods temporarily imported

The return of a deposit or the release of a security taken under section 181
of the Act on any goods temporarily imported, which are required to be exported
in accordance with that section, shall be subject to the condition that written notice
of not less than 6 working hours shall, if required by the Manager, be given of
intention to export the goods.

94 When drawback allowed

Drawback

(1) Except as provided in regulation 95 hereof, drawback of the full amount of duty paid may, unless the Manager otherwise directs, be allowed in cases in which the following conditions are complied with –
(a) Written notice of not less than 6 working hours shall, if required by the Manager be given of intention to ship goods for export under drawback, and the exporter shall pay to the Manager a charge at the rate prescribed in regulation 13 for the time an officer is employed during working hours in the examination of the goods and the relevant documents, together with any expenses incurred as certified by the Manager; and payment of drawback shall not be made until the charge and expenses have been paid:
Provided that the said charge shall not be paid in respect of goods
exported by post by any person not engaged in business;
(b) Where imported goods are exported under drawback, the exporter
shall show on the drawback entry the kind, number, and date of
the entry on which duty was paid;
(c) Before examination of any goods for drawback, the exporter shall
produce the invoice or invoices (if any) that were produced when
the goods were entered for home consumption, together with such
other documents or particulars relating to the transaction as the
proper officer requires;
(d) On completion of the packing of the goods, the packages shall, if so
required by the Manager be secured and sealed by the proper officer,
and be forthwith conveyed to the place of shipment and shipped;
or, if not so forthwith conveyed and shipped, the packages shall be
removed to some place of security approved by the Manager.
(2) The Manager may, in his discretion, dispense with all or any of the
requirements paragraph (1) (b) or (c).
(3) Except in respect of goods exported by post by persons not engaged in
business, the drawback claimed in respect of any one entry shall not be less than
$1.
(4) Drawback of the full amount of duty paid on imported raw tobacco may be allowed in accordance with any claim made in form 62, and in any such case paragraph (1) shall not apply.

95 Conditions governing drawback in special cases

(1) If the Manager so permits in any particular case, and subject to any
conditions imposed by him, drawback may be allowed on the following goods,
namely –
(a) Spirits, spiritous mixtures, wine, tobacco, cigars, cigarettes, or snuff: Provided that where the Manager is satisfied that the goods cannot be conveniently obtained from a warehouse he may allow drawback thereon;

Customs 141

(b) Goods that have been used in Niue after delivery from the control of the Customs:
Provided that goods which the Manager is satisfied have been temporarily used only for trial, inspection, or demonstration shall not be deemed to have been used within the meaning of this paragraph;
(c) Goods that have been damaged or have deteriorated in condition, after removal from the control of the Customs;
(d) Goods the current domestic value of which, if sold duty-paid for
home consumption in Niue at the time of application for drawback,
would be less than the amount of drawback for which claim can be
made;
(e) The goods described in section 183 (1)(c) of the Act.
(2) When the approval of the Manager is necessary under this regulation
for the allowance of drawback on any goods, no person shall make entry for the
goods under drawback until that approval is obtained.
(3) Unless the Manager otherwise permits, regulation 94 shall apply to the
goods described in this regulation.

96 Manager may waive non-compliance with conditions

The Manager may, on such conditions as he thinks fit, allow payment of
drawback, although the provisions of these Regulations in respect thereof have
not been strictly complied with.

97 Entry for drawback

(1) In the case of imported raw tobacco used in the manufacture of tobacco
in a tobacco-manufacturing warehouse, the delivery of form 62 to the Manager or
other proper officer shall be deemed to be entry for drawback of any goods in
respect of which Part B of that form is completed.
(2) In the case of any other goods, entry for drawback shall be made in
form 35 and delivered to the Manager or other proper officer.

98 Reimportation of goods exported under drawback

(1) Subject to the conditions set out in paragraph (2), the following classes
of goods may be reimported into Niue notwithstanding that they have been
exported under drawback –
(a) Ships’ stores of the kind referred to in regulation 41 (a);
(b) Travellers’ samples;
(c) Goods exported for sale or return;
(d) Goods the delivery of which has been refused by the consignee;
(e) Goods which the Manager, in any special case, may permit to be
reimported.
(2) The conditions referred to in paragraph (1) –
(a) The Manager may require the importer to produce at his own
expense such reasonable evidence as is necessary to establish the
qualification of the goods to be reimported under this regulation;
(b) Duty shall be paid thereon as if the goods were being imported for
the first time:
Provided that, unless the Manager otherwise directs, the duty payable thereon
shall be not less than the amount of drawback that was allowed on the exportation
of the goods.
142 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 6
TOBACCO

99 Returns of tobacco, and materials other than tobacco, used in manufacture

The licensee of every tobacco-manufacturing warehouse shall, within 15
days after the end of every month, send to the Manager in forms 62 and 63, extracts
of the accounts of all tobacco and other materials received into his warehouse and
used in the manufacture of tobacco.

100 ––

PART 7
METHYLATED SPIRIT

General Provisions as to Methylation

101 Minimum strength for spirit

(1) No person shall methylate any spirits that are of a lower strength than
50 over proof as ascertained by Sikes’s hydrometer.
(2) No person shall use for the purpose of methylation any wood naphtha,
pyridine, or methyl violet dye that has not been approved by the Manager.

102 Samples of substances for purposes of methylation

(1) Samples of wood naphtha, pyridine, or methyl violet dye to be
submitted for approval must be drawn and sealed in their containers in the
presence of an officer of Customs.
(2) Such samples must not be less than 300 millilitres in the case of wood
naphtha and pyridine and 15 grams in the case of methyl violet dye, and the
container must bear a label setting forth the marks and numbers of the packages
of importation, the name of the manufacturer or supplier of the goods, and the
name of the country of origin of the goods.
(3) The label must also bear the initials of the officer in whose presence the
samples were drawn.
(4) After the samples are drawn the bulk goods represented by the samples
must forthwith be stored in a place of security approved by the Manager:
Provided that wood naphtha, pyridine, and methyl violet dye in vessels
that can be securely sealed to the satisfaction of the Manager may be delivered
from Customs control when the vessels have been sealed with the Customs seal.

103 Standard for wood naphtha

(1) No wood naphtha shall be approved for use in methylation, unless it
contains –
(a) Not less than 72 percent by volume of methyl alcohol;
(b) Not more than 12 grammes per 100 c.c. of acetone, aldehydes, and
higher ketones, estimated as “acetone” by the formation of iodoform
according to Messinger ’s method;
(c) Not more than 3 grammes per 100 c.c. of esters, estimated as methyl-
acetate by hydrolysis.
(2) Wood naphtha for use in methylation shall also comply with the
following tests –
(a) Not more than 30 c.c. of the naphtha shall be required to decolourise
a solution containing 0.5 grammes of bromine;
(b) The naphtha, which must be neutral or only slightly alkaline to
litmus, shall require at least 5c.c. of decinormal acid to neutralise
25 c.c. of the naphtha when methyl orange is used as the indicator.

Customs 143

104 Standard for pyridine

No pyridine shall be approved for use in methylation, unless it consists of
the bases derived from coal tar and unless it conforms to the following tests –
(a) It shall not be more deeply coloured than a solution of 2 ml of
decinormal iodine dissolved in 1 litre of water;
(b) It shall mix readily and completely with spirits, and shall give a
clear or only slightly opalescent solution when mixed with twice
its volume of water;
(c) 10ml of a 1-percent solution of the pyridine in water on vigorous
shaking, after the addition of 5 ml of an aqueous solution of
cadmium chloride containing 5 grammes of the anhydrous fused
salt in 100 ml, shall produce immediately a distinct crystalline
precipitate and an abundant separation of crystals within 10
minutes;
(d) A white precipitate shall be formed when 10 ml of a 1-percent
solution of the pyridine in water are mixed with 5 ml of Nessler ’s
reagent;
(e) 1 ml of crude pyridine dissolved in 10 ml of distilled water shall
require not less than 9.5 ml of normal sulphuric acid for
neutralisation, using Congo Red paper as the indicator;
(f) 100ml slowly heated under the conditions laid down for benzol for
motor fuel by the British Engineering Standards Association (B.S.
Specification 658 of 1962) shall give a distillate of at least 50 ml at a
temperature of 140°C and of 90 ml at 160°C.

105 Standard for methyl violet dye

No methyl violet dye shall be approved for use in methylation, unless it is
of the standard of the aniline dye referred to as Basic Violet 1 in the Colour Index
42535 (second edition).

106 Manufacture, use, and sale of methylated spirit

(1) No person shall manufacture any kind of methylated spirit other than
one of the kinds referred to in regulations 107, 109, 112, 114, 121, and 124.
(2) No person shall manufacture any kind of methylated spirit otherwise
than with the ingredients, and the proportions of the ingredients, prescribed by
or under such one of the regulations referred to in paragraph (1) as is applicable
to that kind of methylated spirit.
(3) No person shall manufacture any methylated spirit except under the
supervision of an officer of Customs.
(4) No person shall manufacture, use, sell or otherwise dispose of any
methylated spirit except in compliance with the succeeding provisions of this Part
so far as they are applicable.

107 Completely denatured spirit

Methylated spirit (hereinafter referred to as completely denatured spirit)
for sale without restriction, save as provided by regulation 108 may be made by
the admixture of the following ingredients in the following proportions –
Ethyl alcohol or neutral spirit: 100 litres
Approved wood naphtha: 5 litres
Approved pyridine: Not less than 500 millilitres
Methyl violet: 156 milligrams
144 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

108 Containers of denatured spirit to be labelled

(1) Every vendor of completely denatured spirit shall, before the sale cause
each vessel containing the spirit to have securely attached to it a label with the
following words printed on it and conforming to paragraph (2).
Methylated Spirit
POISONOUS
NOT TO BE TAKEN INTERNALLY
If so taken it may cause blindness or death, and it will induce general physical
decay.
(2) On the label the word “POISONOUS” and the words “NOT TO BE
TAKEN INTERNALLY” shall be printed in bold sans serif capital letters not less
than 3mm in height.

109 Ingredients

Methylated Spirit (Pyridinised)

Methylated spirit (hereinafter referred to as methylated spirit (pyridicinised)) may be made by the admixture of the following ingredients in the following proportions –
Ethyl alcohol or neutral spirit: 100 litres
Approved wood naphtha: 5 litres
Approved pyridine: Not less than 500 millilitres

110 Manufacture and disposal

(1) No person shall manufacture, sell, or otherwise dispose of any
methylated spirit (pyridinised) except –
(a) For use by a person on his own premises and in the manufacture of
varnishes, lacquers, and stains, or such other articles or goods as
may be approved by the Manager; or
(b) For such other special purposes as the Manager approves.
(2) No person shall sell or otherwise dispose of any methylated spirit
(pyridinised) in a package, unless before delivery the package is distinctly marked
“Methylated spirit (pyridinised)”.
(3) No person shall manufacture, sell, or otherwise dispose of any
methylated spirit (pyridinised), except in such quantity as the Manager may direct
or permit.
(4) No person shall sell or otherwise dispose of any methylated spirit
(pyridinised) unless –
(a) There is first produced to him by the purchaser or person acquiring
it a written permit from the Manager authorising the acquisition of
the quantity to be supplied; and
(b) He endorses on the permit the date of supply and the quantity
supplied by him, and verifies the endorsement by signing it.
(5) For the purposes of paragraph (4)(a) the quantity for the time being
authorised by any such permit to be acquired shall be that remaining after the
deduction from the quantity originally stated therein of the quantities of all
acquisitions thereunder of which particulars have been noted on the permit.

Customs 145

111 Purchase and use

(1) No person shall purchase or otherwise acquire any methylated spirit
(pyridinised), except in pursuance of a written permit so to do issued to him by
the Manager and for the purpose set out in the permit.
(2) Before a permit to purchase is issued to any person under this regulation,
he shall make a declaration under the Customs Acts that he will use the spirit
only on his own premises and in the manufacture of varnishes, lacquers, and stains,
or such other articles or goods as the Manager approves, or for such other special
purposes as the Manager approves, and that he will not sell or otherwise dispose
of any such spirit except on the production by the purchaser or person acquiring
it of a written permit from the Manager authorising the purchase or acquisition.
(3) No person shall use any methylated spirit (pyridinised), except on his
own premises and in the manufacture of varnishes, lacquers, and stains, or such
other articles or goods as the Manager approves, or for such other special purposes
as the Manager approves.

112 Ingredients

Methylated “Finish”

Methylated spirit (hereinafter referred to as methylated “finish” without pyridine) for sale without restriction, save as provided by regulation 113 hereof, may be made by the admixture of the following ingredients, in the following proportions –
Ethyl alcohol or neutral spirit: 100 parts by volume
Approved wood naphtha: 5 parts by volume
Shellac copal or other resins: At least 10 parts by weight to every 100 parts
by weight of the rectified spirit.

113 Sale or disposal

No person shall sell or otherwise dispose of any methylated “finish” without
pyridine in a package, unless before delivery –
(a) All resins therein have been dissolved to the satisfaction of the
supervising officer; and
(b) The package is distinctly marked “Methylated finish W.P.” or
“Methylated finish without pyridine”.

114 Ingredients

Methylated Spirit Without Pyridine (W.P.)

Methylated spirit (hereinafter referred to as methylated spirit W.P.) may be made by the admixture of the following ingredients in the following proportions –
Ethyl alcohol or neutral spirit: 100 litres
Approved wood naphtha: 5 litres

115 Manufacture and disposal

(1) No person shall manufacture, sell, or otherwise dispose of any
methylated spirit W.P., except –
(a) For use by a person on his own premises in the manufacture of
varnishes, lacquers, stains, and polishes; or
(b) For use in furniture polishing; or
(c) For use by a person on his own premises in the manufacture of
other articles or goods approved by the Manager; or
(d) For such other special purposes as the Manager approves.
146 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(2) No person shall sell or otherwise dispose of any methylated spirit W.P. in a package, unless before delivery the package is distinctly marked “Methylated spirit W.P. for furniture polishing” (or otherwise as the case may require).
(3) No person shall manufacture, sell or otherwise dispose of any methylated spirit W.P., except in such quantity as the Manager directs or permits. (4) No person shall sell or otherwise dispose of any methylated spirit W.P.
unless –
(a) There is first produced to him by the purchaser or person acquiring it a written permit from the Manager authorising the acquisition of the quantity to be supplied; and
(b) He endorses on the permit the date of supply and the quantity supplied by him, and verifies the endorsement by signing it.
(5) For the purposes of paragraph (4)(a) the quantity for the time being authorised by any such permit to be acquired shall be that remaining after the deduction from the quantity originally stated therein of the quantities of all acquisitions thereunder of which particulars have been noted on the permit.

116 Purchase and use

(1) No person shall purchase or otherwise acquire any methylated spirit
W.P., except in pursuance of a written permit so to do issued to him by the Manager
and for the purpose set out in the permit.
(2) Before a permit to purchase is issued to any person under this regulation,
he shall make a declaration under the Customs Acts that he will use the spirit
only for a purpose to be named therein, being such one or more of the following
purposes as is set out in the permit, namely –
(a) For use on his own premises in the manufacture of varnishes,
lacquers, stains, and polishes;
(b) For use in furniture polishing;
(c) For use on his own premises in the manufacture of other articles or
goods approved by the Manager;
(d) For such other special purposes as the Manager may approve –
and that he will not sell or otherwise dispose of any methylated spirit W.P. acquired
by him under the permit, except on the production by the purchaser or person
acquiring it of a written permit from the Manager authorising the purchase or
acquisition.
(3) Before a permit to purchase is issued to any person under this regulation,
he shall, if the Manager so requires, give security that the spirit will not be used or
disposed of otherwise than in terms of the declaration under the Customs Acts
prescribed by paragraph (2).
(4) No person shall use any methylated spirit W.P. purchased or otherwise
acquired by him in pursuance of a permit issued under this regulation, otherwise
than for the purpose set out in the permit.

117 Record of manufacture, purchase, sale and use

(1) Every manufacturer or holder for sale of any methylated spirit W.P.
shall keep on the premises where the spirit is kept a book (which shall be open to
inspection by any officer of Customs) in which he shall enter with respect to all
such spirit the following particulars –
(a) The quantity manufactured or purchased;
(b) The date of manufacture or purchase;
(c) The name and address of the person to whom delivered;
(d) The quantity delivered;
(e) The date of delivery.

Customs 147

(2) The entries specified in paragraph (1)(a) and (b) shall be made not later than the day following the date of manufacture or purchase; and the entries specified in paragraph (1)(c), (d), and (e) shall be made not later than the day following the date of delivery.
(3) Every person by whom methylated spirit W.P. is used –
(a) In the manufacture of varnishes, lacquers, stains, and polishes; or
(b) In the manufacture of other articles or goods approved by the
Manager;
shall keep on the factory premises a book in which, immediately on receipt of any
methylated spirit W.P. he shall enter particulars thereof. He shall also immediately
after use of methylated spirit W.P. enter in that book the quantity used. The book
shall be open to inspection by any officer of Customs, who shall be permitted to
check the balances shown therein with the stock of methylated spirit on hand:
Provided that this paragraph may, in the discretion of the Manager, be waived in
the case of persons using less than 20 litres a month of methylated spirit W.P. for
approved purposes.
(4) Every person required to keep a book pursuant to this regulation shall
keep the book for a period of 2 years from the date of the last entry therein or until
he ceases at an earlier date to carry on business in the premises where the book is
kept, and in the latter event shall deposit the book with the Manager for custody
and reference.

118 Place of security

Every holder of methylated spirit W.P. for sale or for manufacturing
purposes shall provide a room or place of security for the storage of the spirit,
subject to the approval of the Manager and to such conditions as the Manager
considers necessary.

119 Partially manufactured products

No manufacturer of varnishes, lacquers, stains, or polishes, or of other
articles or goods approved by the Manager, shall sell or otherwise dispose of any
partially manufactured products containing methylated spirit W.P.

120 Manufacture under supervision

The Manager may direct that any articles or goods in the manufacture of
which the use of methylated spirit W.P. is approved shall be manufactured under
the supervision of an officer of Customs and that delivery of such articles or goods
from Customs control shall not be made until the ingredients used in manufacture
have come into solution, or until the process of maceration or of percolation (where
necessary) is complete.

121 Ingredients

Spirit Methylated with Phenol

Methylated spirit (hereinafter referred to as spirit methylated with phenol) may be made by the addition to ethyl alcohol or neutral spirit of 1 percent by volume of absolute phenol.

122 Manufacture and disposal

(1) No person shall manufacture, sell, or otherwise dispose of any spirit
methylated with phenol, except for use in a public or private hospital.
(2) No person shall dispose of any package containing spirit methylated
with phenol unless, before delivery, the package is distinctly marked “Methylated
spirit for exclusive use in hospitals”.
148 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(3) No person shall manufacture, sell, or otherwise dispose of any spirit methylated with phenol, except in such quantity as the Manager directs or permits. (4) No person acting on behalf of any public or private hospital shall purchase spirit methylated with phenol, except in pursuance of a written permit so to do issued by the Manager to the chief medical officer of the public hospital or to the licensee of the private hospital. Before any such permit issued, the chief medical officer of the public hospital or the licensee of the private hospital shall make a declaration under the Customs Acts that the spirit will be used exclusively for bona fide hospital purposes other than the manufacture or compounding of
medicines, medicaments, medicinal preparations, or spiritous iodine solutions. (5) No person shall use any spirit methylated with phenol otherwise than
for bona fide hospital purposes, and no person shall use any spirit methylated
with phenol for the manufacture or compounding of medicines, medicaments,
medicinal preparations, or spiritous iodine solutions.

123 Provisions as to methylated spirit W.P. to apply to spirit methylated with phenol

Regulation 117 (1), (2) and (4) and regulation 118, as far as they are applicable and with the necessary modifications, shall apply with respect to spirit methylated with phenol and to every manufacturer and holder for sale of spirit methylated with phenol.

124 Other formulas

Miscellaneous Provisions

Methylated spirit may be made in accordance with any other formula approved in writing by the Manager and setting out the ingredients and proportions of ingredients thereof, but only for such purposes and on and subject to such conditions as the Manager in writing permits or imposes.

125 Revocation of approval or permit

Any approval granted by the Manager under this Part with respect to the
methylation of spirit or the use of such spirit in the manufacture of articles or
goods, and any permit issued by the Manager under this Part, may be revoked at
any time.

126 Fee for officer’s time

Charges at the rates prescribed by these Regulations shall be paid to the
Manager for the time an officer of Customs is employed in supervising the
manufacture or delivery of any methylated spirit, “finish”, or other articles or
goods made under the authority of this Part.
PART 8
POWERS OF OFFICERS OF CUSTOMS

127 Taking of samples

(1) When it is deemed necessary to take samples pursuant to section 221
of the Act the importer or his agent shall be advised that it is intended to take such
samples.
(2) Such samples shall be taken only in the presence of the importer or his
agent, except in cases where the Manager may consider it impracticable to do so.

Customs 149

128 Use of samples

Samples taken in accordance with section 221 of the Act, or provided by
the importer in accordance with section 61 of the Act, shall be used in whatever
manner is deemed by the Manager or other proper officer to be most suitable to
achieve the purpose for which they were taken or provided.

129 Disposal of samples

(1) When not further required, all samples taken pursuant to section 221
of the Act, and not consumed or destroyed in the process of examination, weighing,
analysis, or testing, shall, on application by the importer, be returned to him.
(2) If no application is received within 1 month after the results of the
examination, weighing, analysis, or testing have been known to the importer, or
if, after any application is so received, the goods are not removed within a further
month by the importer, they may be sold or destroyed by the Manager as he thinks
fit.

130 Examination, measurement of goods

With the consent of the importer, the Manager may, in his discretion, permit
any person to measure, count, weight, gauge, test, or examine any goods subject
to the control of the Customs.
PART 9
AGENTS AND CARRIERS

Agents

131 Approval of employees as agents

The Manager may, on application made in writing in such form as he may
require by any licensed Customs agent, approve of any servant or clerk, in the
exclusive employment of that Customs agent, acting as agent in accordance with
section 231 (1) of the Act.

132 Customs agents’ licences

For the purposes of section 231 of the Act, the Manager may on written
application, and in accordance with this Part of these regulations, grant to any
person a Customs agent’s licence of one of the following kinds –
(a) A Customs agent’s licence (Individuan( �
(b) A Customs agent’s licence (Generan( �
(c) A Customs agent’s licence (Restricted).

133 Customs agent’s licence (Individuan( �/p>

(1) A Customs agent’s licence (Individual) may be granted to any individual
in respect of whom the Manager is satisfied that he is the holder of a New Zealand
Certificate in Commerce (Customs option) issued by the Technicians Certification
Authority of New Zealand.
(2) The Manager may, in his discretion, grant a Customs agent’s licence
(Individual) to an individual who is not the holder of such a certificate as aforesaid,
if in the Manager ’s opinion special circumstances exist that justify the grant of the
licence.
(3) A Customs agent’s licence (Individual) shall authorise the holder,
pursuant to the terms of the licence, to carry on the business of a Customs agent at
any port of entry.
150 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

113A Customs agent’s licence (Generan( �/p>

(1) A Customs agent’s licence (General) may be granted to any company
within the meaning of the Companies Act 2006 or any overseas company within
the meaning of that Act which is carrying on business in Niue in respect of which
the Manager is satisfied that it has in its employment, at every port of entry at
which it carries on or intends to carry on business as a Customs agent, at least one
person who is the holder of a Customs agent’s licence (Individual).
(2) Subject to this regulation, a Customs agent’s licence (General) shall
authorise the company holding it to carry on the business of a Customs agent at
any port of entry.
(3) It shall be a condition of the licence that the company holding it shall
not carry on the business of a Customs agent at any port unless it has in its
employment at that port at least one person who is the holder of a Customs agent’s
licence (Individual).
(4) Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing provisions of this regulation,
the Manager may at any time in his discretion, and subject to such conditions as
he thinks fit, by writing authorise the company holding the licence to carry on the
business of a Customs agent at any specified port notwithstanding that there is
not in the company’s employment at that port a person holding a Customs agent’s
licence (Individual). Any such authority may at any time in like manner be revoked
or varied.

133B Customs agent’s licence (Restricted)

(1) A Customs agent’s licence (Restricted) may be granted, subject to such
conditions as the Manager thinks fit, to any individual or company or body
corporate.
(2) A Customs agent’s licence (Restricted) shall authorise the holder to act
as a Customs agent in respect of such transactions, or for such purposes, or in
such circumstances, and subject in any case to such conditions, as may be specified
in the licence.

133C Applications for licences

Every applicant for a Customs agent’s licence shall supply to the Manager
such information as he may reasonably require for the purposes of this Part.

133D Refusal of licence

Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing provisions of this Part, the
Manager may refuse to grant an application for any Customs agent’s licence if –
(a) The applicant has been convicted of an offence against any of the
Customs Acts, or of any offence involving dishonesty; or
(b) The Manager is satisfied on reasonable grounds that the applicant
is not a fit person to act as a Customs agent, by reason of bad
character, or incompetence, or insufficient practical experience in
the kind of work normally carried on by Customs agents.

133E Variation of licence

(1) Subject to regulation 133G the Manager may from time to time, by notice
in writing to the holder of any Customs agent’s licence, vary or revoke any
condition specified in the licence, or add any new condition.
(2) Subject as aforesaid, every such notice shall have effect according to its
tenor and shall be deemed to be part of the licence.

Customs 151

133F Revocation or suspension of licence

(1) Subject to the provisions of this regulation and regulation 133G the
Manager may at any time revoke or suspend any Customs agent’s licence on any
one or more of the following grounds, namely –
(a) That any condition of the licence has not been or is not being
complied with;
(b) That the holder has been convicted of an offence against any of the
Customs Acts or of any offence involving dishonesty;
(c) That in the opinion of the Manager, based on reasonable grounds
the holder is incompetent, or has been guilty of misconduct or grave
impropriety in connection with the carrying out of any transaction
as a Customs agent, and for that reason is not a fit person to continue
to act as a Customs agent;
(d) That, in the case of a Customs agent’s licence (Restricted), the holder
has acted as a Customs agent in respect of any transaction, or for
any purpose, or in any circumstances, not for the time being
specified in the licence.
(2) Before deciding to revoke or suspend the licence the Manager shall –
(a) Give to the holder of the licence not less than 21 days notice in
writing stating his intention to evoke or suspend it, and specifying
briefly the grounds of the proposed revocation or suspension;
(b) Consider any representations that may be made to him by or on
behalf of the holder within the period of the notice or such further
period as the Manager may allow;
(c) If the holder so requests, afford him an opportunity of being heard
within such period or further period as aforesaid.
(3) Notwithstanding any provisions of this regulation by any such notice
the Manager may withdraw the licence forthwith pending his decision whether
to revoke or suspend it; and while the licence is so withdrawn the holder shall be
deemed not to be a licensed Customs agent.
(4) If the Manager decides to revoke or suspend the licence he shall give
written notice of the revocation or suspension as the case may be to the holder.
(5) The period of suspension of any Customs agent’s licence shall in no
case exceed 1 year.

133G Appeals

(1) If the Manager –
(a) Under regulation 133D refuses to grant an application for a licence;
or
(b) Under regulation 133E varies or revokes any condition specified in
a licence or adds any new condition; or
(c) Under regulation 133F revokes or suspends a licence –
the applicant or, as the case may be, the holder of the licence may, within 14 days
after notice of the Manager ’s decision is received by him, appeal to the Court, by
way of originating application, against the Manager ’s decision.
(2) On the hearing of the appeal the Court, whose decision shall be final,
may confirm or reverse or modify the Manager ’s decision.
152 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

134 Security by agents

Before any such licence is granted, the applicant shall give security to the
satisfaction of the Manager.

135 Licence fee

(1) There shall be payable to the Manager in respect of every Customs
agent’s licence an annual fee of $2.
(2) The fee shall be payable on the first issue of the licence, and also on or
before the 15th day of January in each succeeding year until the licence is given
up or cancelled.
(3) The Manager may cancel any licence in respect of which the annual fee
remains unpaid for 30 days after it becomes due.

136 Customs carriers

Customs Carriers

The Manager may, on written application, grant a licence to any person approved by him to act as a Customs carrier.

137 Revocation of carrier’s licence

Any Customs carrier ’s licence may be revoked by the Manager by order in
writing; but the licensee may, within 14 days after notice of the revocation, appeal
to the Minister against the order, and the Minister ’s decision thereon shall be final.

138 Security by carriers

Before any Customs carrier ’s licence is granted, the person applying for
the licence shall, when the Manager so requires, give security to the satisfaction of
the Manager in such form as the Manager may require.

139 Notice of seizure

PART 10
FORFEITURES
Notice of seizure of any goods that have been seized as forfeited shall be in form 51.

140 Notice to dispute forfeiture

Notice to dispute the forfeiture of goods seized shall be in form 52.
PART 11
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

Declarations

141 Form of declarations

All declarations required or authorised by the Customs Acts shall, when
not elsewhere prescribed, be in form 54.

142 Verification of information by declaration

Any information required or authorised by these Regulations shall, when
deemed necessary by the Manager, be verified by declaration in form 54.

Special Provisions as to the Post Office

143 “Postal packet” defined

For the purposes of regulations 144 to 148 “postal packet” means any letter,
parcel, packet, or other article whatever received or transmitted by or through the
Post Office.

Customs 153

144 When entry for postal packets not required

(1) Except when required by the Manager it shall not be necessary for any
importer to make entry for postal packets in the following cases –
(a) When the current domestic value of the goods imported by him by
any one mail is less than $20; or
(b) When the importer is a person not engaged in business and the
goods are exempt from the requirement of a licence to import under
any law for the time being in force relating to import control; or
(c) When the duty on the goods is paid by some person outside Niue.
(2) In such cases the postal packets shall be deemed to have been entered
for home consumption when application is made by the importer for their delivery.

145 Powers of officers of Post Office

Officers of the Post Office may, in respect of postal packets, exercise or
perform for the purposes of the Customs Acts all or any of the powers or duties of
any importer or exporter, and, with the consent of the Manager, of those of an
officer of Customs.

146 Disposal of postal packets by Postmaster

When entry of any postal packet is not made within the prescribed time or
within such further time as the Manager may see fit to allow, the Manager may
permit the Postmaster to return the postal packet to the sender.

147 Several postal packets may be treated as a single package

Postal packets posted by any one exporter, whether addressed to the same
or different persons, may, if the Manager so directs, be treated for the purposes of
the Customs Acts as a single package consigned to a single person.

148 Person forwarding packets may be treated as importer

For the purposes of the Customs Acts the person forwarding postal packets
to Niue may, if the Manager so decides, be deemed to be the importer of the goods.

149 Exemption from entry

(1) In such cases as may be approved by the Manager, it shall not be
necessary for any exporter to make entry for export of any goods exported by
post.
(2) Any goods to which paragraph (1) applies shall be deemed to have been entered for export when they have been accepted for posting by the Post Office.

Miscellaneous Provisions

150 Persons engaged in business

If any dispute arises as to whether any person is engaged in business for
the purposes of these Regulations, the Manager ’s decision thereon shall be final.

151 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person commits an offence who does any act in contravention of
or fails to comply with any provision of these Regulations.
(2) Every person who commits an offence against these Regulations is liable
on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding one penalty unit.
–––––––––––––––––––
154 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE 1 [Revoked]

SCHEDULE 2

SCALES OF ANNUAL FEES FOR WAREHOUSES

Part 1

Scale of fees for warehouses licensed for the warehousing of liquids other than ethyl alcohol, neutral

Scale of fees for warehouses licensed as tobacco-manufacturing warehouses.

Where the total quantity of tobacco, cigars, cigarettes, Annual Fee and snuff manufactured –

Does not exceed 23,000kg $200

Exceeds 23,000kg but does not exceed 46,000kg $300

Exceeds 46,000kg but does not exceed 920,000kg $300 plus $80 for

each 46,000kg in

excess of 46,000kg

Exceeds 920,000kg but does not exceed 2,300,000kg $1820 plus $40 for

each 46,000kg in

excess of 920,000kg

Exceeds 2,300,000kg $3020 plus $20 for

each 46,000kg in

excess of 2,300,000kg

Provided that –

(a) Where the total quantity of manufactured tobacco produced during any

year is found to be greater than that for which the fee was computed the

licensee shall be liable for the proper fee for such greater quantity;

(b) Where the total quantity of manufactured tobacco produced during any

year is found to be less than that for which the fee was computed the

Manager may refund the difference between the fee paid for that year

and the fee that would have been payable if calculated on the basis of the

total quantity of manufactured tobacco actually produced during the year.

Part 3

Scale of fees for warehouses not subject to the fees set out in Parts 1 and 2 of this Schedule

Cubic Content of Warehouse

Annual Fee

Less than 240 m3

150

Not less than 240 m3 and less than 600 m3

250

Not less than 600 m3 and less than 1,200m3

500

Not less than 1,200 m3 and less than 1,800 m3

750

Not less than 1,800 m3 and less than 2,400 m3

1,000

Not less than 2,400 m3

1,250

–––––––––––––––––––

Customs 155

SCHEDULE 3

Regs 70, 71

LIST OF PARTLY MANUFACTURED MATERIALS REFERRED TO IN REGULATIONS 70 AND 71

Abrasive materials, including corumdum, alumdum, carborundum, emery and similar materials;

Argols; Asbestos, fibre;

Asphalt, bitumen, tar and pitch; Barium carbonate, barium sulphate; Bromine and iodine;

Camphor, laurel, crude; Carbon-black or gas-black; Cellulose acetate film base; Cherries in brine;

Coir yarn;

Cork strip for tipping cigarettes;

Dyes and vegetable substances used in making dyes;

Earth colours, dry ground;

Fibres, natural, animal or vegetable, even though sorted, dressed, scoured, or

similarly treated, including raw silk, organzine, tram silk, grege, poil, crepe,

grenadine, and single sun schappe yarn;

Graphite, natural or artificial, in powder form;

Greenstone and precious stones cut and/or polished;

Gums and resins, refined;

Hides and skins, with or without wool or hair, salted, or pickled;

Isinglass;

Lemon or orange rinds in brine;

Liquorice extract, in bulk;

Magnesite, calcined;

Meats and fish, fresh, chilled or frozen;

Metals in the form of pigs or ingots or in cruder forms (e.g. mattes, concentrates,

regulus), mercury; copper or zinc in bars, blocks, cakes and slabs; iron or steel

blooms, billets, or slabs; iron bars (Swedish) made from iron puddled with

charcoal; ferro-silicon; metal scrap, suitable for resmelting;

Nitrocellulose film base;

Oils, essential, natural; oil of turpentine;

Oils, viz., whale oils and fish oils, crude; Chinese wood-oil, palm oil, olive oil,

crude or refined;

Potassium, chloride and sulphate of;

Rags, or waste, cotton or linen, for respinning or for paper and pulp making;

Rags, woollen, for respinning or for making flock;

Rubber, viz., crepe rubber, guttapercha and balata, crude;

Sodium nitrate;

Sponges, unbleached;

Strawboard (of Dutch type);

Sugar, unrefined, and molasses;

Sulphur, in blocks;

Tanning extracts, vegetable;

Tanning materials, vegetable, viz., barks, sumach, gambier, and similar materials,

ground or powdered;

Timber, hewn or rough-sawn; also brier-root or similar blocks, rough-shaped for

making tobacco pipes;

Titanium oxide;

Waxes, animal, mineral or vegetable, refined or unrefined;

156 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Wood-pulp, chemical or mechanical.

Note – The following are regarded as examples of unmanufactured raw

materials for the purposes of these Regulations;

Natural products (e.g. minerals; animals; plants, shrubs, trees, vegetables,

or parts thereof such as leaves, barks, fruit, pods, nuts, nut kernels, or

roots) which have not been subjected to any industrial process or processes

except (a) those primary processes whereby natural products are

ordinarily obtained from the farm, mine, forest, fisheries, etc., and (b) the

processes of cleaning, separating, sorting and drying, and of the killing

of animals. For example –

Bones, hoofs and horns; tusks (ivory)

Cork, unmanufactured

Grain or seeds, leaned or graded, but otherwise unmanufactured

Logs, unwrought

Ores, metallic

Petroleum, crude

Salt, rick

Skins, raw or sun-dried

Wool, greasy, washed or scoured

Customs 157

EXPORT LICENCES REGULATIONS 1966

SR1966/90 – 8 June 1966

1 Title

These are the Export Licences Regulations 1966.

2 Interpretation

In these regulations –
“goods” means all kinds of personal property, and includes any ship and
any animal;
“Minister” means the Minister of Customs.

3 Goods not to be exported without licence

(1) Except as provided in regulation 11 no goods shall be exported from
Niue except in accordance with these regulations and with the terms of a licence
issued under this regulations.
(2) These regulations shall apply with respect to the export of any goods,
notwithstanding that a licence or other authority for the export of the goods may
be in force under any Act or under any regulations other than these regulations.
(3) The issue of a licence under these regulations with respect to any goods
shall not absolve any person from the obligation to comply with the requirements
of any Act or of any other regulations with respect to the export of the goods.

4 Kinds of licences

(1) A licence under these regulations may be –
(a) A particular licence; or
(b) A general licence; or
(c) A purchaser ’s licence.
(2) A particular licence shall be a licence to export the goods specified
therein in a ship or aircraft specified therein.
(3) A general licence shall be a licence to export goods from Niue during a
specified period. Any such licence shall, according to its tenor, apply with respect
to goods of all kinds, or be limited to the specified kind or specified kinds of
goods mentioned therein.
(4) A purchaser ’s licence shall be a licence to export from Niue any goods
that have been purchased in Niue out of any credit or currency made available in
Niue in exchange for any overseas credit or currency, in order to provide for the
purchase of the goods for export.

5 Applications for licences

(1) Application may be made –
(a) For a particular licence or a purchaser ’s licence to the Manager with
whom the entry for export is to be lodged.
(b) For a general licence, to the Manager.
(2) Every application for a particular licence or a purchaser ’s licence shall
be made on the entry.
(3) Every application for a general licence shall be made in quadruplicate.
158 Niue Laws 2005 Vol 4

6 Forms of applications and licences

Every application and any licence granted shall be –
(a) In the case of a particular licence and a purchaser ’s licence, included
in form 22, 27, or 35 as the case may require, being forms 22, 27 and
35 within the meaning of the Customs Regulations 1968;
(b) In the case of a general licence, in form 2 in the Schedule.

7 Grant or refusal of licence

The Manager may grant any licence applied for or decline to grant it.

8 Revocation of general licence

(1) Any general licence may at any time be revoked by the Manager if he
thinks fit.
(2) On the revocation of a general licence the Manager shall forthwith give
to the licensee notice in writing of the revocation and of the date when the
revocation has become or becomes effective.

9 Security may be required

(1) Before any licence is issued under these regulations the applicant for
the licence shall, if required to do so by the Manager, give security for compliance
with the terms of the licence and with the requirements of these regulations.
(2) Unless in any case some other security is accepted as sufficient by the
Manager, the security referred to in paragraph (1) shall be a bond, in such form as
the Manager approves, executed in favour of the Government of Niue by the
applicant and by one or more sureties approved by the Manager.
(3) Any bond or other security given in respect of a particular licence or a
purchaser ’s licence shall, unless the Manager otherwise determines, be for a sum
equal to twice the estimated value of the goods to which the licence relates at the
time and place of export.
(4) Any bond or other security given in respect of a general licence shall be
for such sum as the Manager considers adequate.

10 Right of appeal to Minister

From any decision of the Manager under these regulations there shall be a
right of appeal to the Minister, whose decision shall be final.

11 Exceptions

(1) Nothing in these regulations shall apply with respect to –
(a) Any goods shipped as stores in any ship or aircraft about to depart
for any country outside Niue;
(b) Any other goods in respect of which the Minister by direction in
writing determines that these regulations shall not apply.
(2) Without limiting the general authority conferred on the Minister by
paragraph (1) any such direction may relate to –
(a) Any goods intended solely for use or consumption in any specified
place or in any specified places;
(b) Any goods of a specified kind or of specified kinds;
(c) Any goods to be exported in a specified manner or at or within a
specified time;
(d) Any goods to be exported by a specified person or a specified class
of persons.
(3) Any direction given by the Minister for the purposes of this regulation
may at any time be varied or revoked in like manner.

Customs 159

12 Offences

(1) Every person commits an offence and is liable in accordance with the
Customs Act 1966 to a penalty not exceeding 2 penalty units who –
(a) In any application for a licence under these regulations, makes or
causes or permits to be made, any statement that to his knowledge
is false or misleading in any material particular; or
(b) In relation to any such application, misleads or attempts to mislead
the Manager; or
(c) Fails to comply with any provision of these regulations.
(2) Nothing in this regulation shall limit the liability of any person under
any provision of section 48 or Part 2 of the Customs Act 1966 in any case to which
any such provision applies.

––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE Form 2

Export Licences Regulations 1966

APPLICATION FOR GENERAL LICENCE TO EXPORT GOODS

To the Revenue Manager, Niue

Full name of applicant: ............................................................................................................... Address: ........................................................................................................................................ Local office of bank in Niue to which shipping documents are to be delivered: ............... Duration of licence: ...................................................................................................................... The applicant hereby applies for a general licence to export goods from Niue in terms of

the particulars set out above.

Date: .................................................... Signature: .........................................

I hereby license the exportation of goods in terms of the above application and in accordance with the Export Licences Regulations 1966.

Date: .................................................... Signature: .........................................

Revenue Manager

160 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

EXPORT PROHIBITION REGULATIONS 1953

SR1953/179 – 1 January 1954

1 These are the Export Prohibition Regulations 1953.

2 No person shall export any goods without the permission in writing of the Minister of Customs.

3 The Minister may grant permission for the export of any goods or goods of any class either generally or to any country or countries or to any person or persons, and any such permission may be subject to such conditions as he may impose.

4 (1) Any person desiring to export goods shall, at least ten days before the date of intended shipment, apply in writing to the Manager at the port at which the goods are proposed to be placed on board the exporting vessel for permission to export the goods. The applicant shall furnish the following particulars –

(a) Description, quantity, and value of goods; (b) Port of intended shipment;

(c) Name of intended exporting vessel;

(d) Approximate intended date of shipment;

(e) Ultimate destination of goods;

(f) Name and address of consignee;

(g) Any other particulars that may be required by the Manager.

(2) The Minister may dispense with all or any of the requirements of this

regulation.

5 Except with the permission of the Manager, entry for export of any goods for the export of which permission is granted shall be made at the Customhouse at the port of loading before shipment of the goods on the exporting vessel.

6 ––

7 The Minister may delegate to the Manager authority to entertain any application for permission to export goods and to grant or withhold any permission that the Minister is empowered by these regulations to grant or withhold, and any permission given by the Manager in the name of the Minister or in his own name, and the conditions thereof, shall for the purposes of these regulations be as effective as if given by the Minister in person.

8 The Minister may at any time before shipment, by notice in writing given to the person to whom the permission was granted, revoke any permission for the export of any goods granted by him or by the Manager and may direct the Manager at any such time as aforesaid and in like manner to revoke any such permission granted by the manager respectively.

9 (1) These regulations shall apply with respect to the export of all goods, notwithstanding that a licence or other authority for the export of any such goods may be in force under the Customs Acts or any other Act or under any regulations other than these regulations.

(2) The granting of permission to export any goods under these regulations shall not absolve any person from the obligation to comply with the requirements of any Act or of any other regulations with respect to the export of the goods.

Customs 161

IMPORT PROHIBITION (INSECTICIDES) ORDER 1964

SR 1964/188 – 30 November 1964

1 This is the Import Prohibition (Insecticides) Order 1964.

2 The importation of the goods specified in the Schedule is prohibited, except with the consent of the Minister of Customs and subject to such conditions as he thinks fit to impose.

––––––––––––––––––––

Benzene hexachloride

SCHEDULE

Dichlorodiphenyltrichlorethane (DDT)

––––––––––––––––––––

IMPORT PROHIBITION (OFFENSIVE WEAPONS) ORDER 1972

SR 1972/223 – 24 October 1972

1 Title

This is the Import Prohibition (Offensive Weapons) Order 1972.

2 Importation of offensive weapons

The importation of the goods specified in the Schedule is hereby prohibited,
except with the consent of the Minister of Customs and subject to such conditions
as he thinks fit to impose.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

Knuckle-dusters, knives incorporating knuckle-dusters, sword-sticks, and any weapon disguised to give the appearance of another article.

Any knife –

(a) Which has a blade which opens automatically by hand pressure applied

to a button, spring, or other device in or attached to the handle of the

knife, sometimes known as a ‘flick knife’ or ‘flick gun’; or

(b) Which has a blade which is released from the handle or sheath thereof by

the force of gravity or the application of centrifugal force and which, when

released, is locked in place by means of a button, spring, lever, or other

device, sometimes known as a ‘gravity knife’.

162 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
goods imported into Niue a port and service tax at the rate of 21/2 per cent

ad valorem.

(2) There shall be exempted from the payment of the tax passengers’
baggage and effects of the following kinds which are not intended for any other
person or for sale, namely –
(a) Wearing apparel and other personal effects which have been worn
or are in use by persons arriving at Niue;
(b) Implements, instructions, and tools of trade, occupation, or
employment of any passenger which have been in use by that
passenger for not less than twelve months prior to his embarkation;
(c) Household or other effects which have been in use for not less than
twelve months prior to embarkation by the persons or families
bringing them to Niue;
Provided that if the household or other effects are not imported within 5
years from the date of the arrival in Niue of the persons or families by whom they
have been used, they shall be exempted under this paragraph only with the
approval of the Minister.

4 For the purposes of these Regulations the value of any goods imported into Niue shall be determined in accordance with the Customs Act 1966.

5 (1) The port and service tax imposed by these Regulations shall constitute a debt due to the Crown by the importer of the goods, and shall be payable before the entry of the goods is passed by the Revenue Manager.

(2) In this regulation the term “importer” has the same meaning as in the
Customs Act 1966.

6 The port and service tax imposed by these Regulations shall be in addition to and not in substitution for any lighterage charge or any other charges payable in respect of the landing of any such goods on Niue.

––––––––––––––––––––

PORT OF ENTRY ORDER 1995

SR 1960/129

[EDITORIAL NOTE: See Niue Legislation as at 1 August 1990 vol 4 p209.]

163

CUSTOMS TARIFF

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The Tariff Schedule is not reproduced here. Copies of the current Schedule may be obtained from the Revenue Manager.

The Tariff Schedule used is the Pacific Harmonised Tariff Schedule 1995. There are no duties payable on goods exported from Niue.]

CUSTOMS TARIFF (GENERAL AMENDMENTS) REGULATIONS 1997

1996/2 – 1 January 1997

1997.
These are the Niue Customs Tariffs (General Amendments) Regulations

2 Revocations

All Regulations passed in accordance with section 7, Niue Customs Act
1982, No 77 and having effect prior to 30 September 1996 are hereby revoked.

3 Customs Tariff Schedule

The Pacific Harmonised Customs Tariff Schedule 1995 shall be incorporated
into and form a part of these Regulations replacing The Pacific Harmonised
Customs Tariff Schedule 1989.

4 Nomenclature and Classification of Goods

The system of nomenclature and classification of goods shall be that system
set out in Schedule 1 of The Pacific Harmonised Customs Tariff Schedule 1995.

5 Duty Rates Payable on Goods Imported into Niue

The duty rates payable on any goods imported into Niue are those rates set
out in Schedule 1 and Schedule 2 of The Pacific Harmonised Customs Tariff
Schedule 1995 as revised by Cabinet prior to the date of these regulations.

6 Duty Rates Payable on Goods Exported from Niue

There shall be no duties payable on any goods exported from Niue.
164 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

CUSTOMS TARIFF (REDUCTION AND ELIMINATION OF TARIFFS) REGULATIONS 2006

2006/1 – 1 January 2005

1 Title

These are the Customs Tariff (Reduction and Elimination of Tariffs)
Regulations 2006, and shall be read together with and deemed part of the Niue
Customs Tariff (General Amendments) Regulations 1997.

2 [Spent]

3 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Least Developed Country” means a Party to the PICTA that is for the time
being designated as a Least Developed Country by the United Nations;
“Small Island States” means the Cook Islands, Kiribati, Nauru, Niue,
Republic of Marshall Islands, Tuvalu, and any other State, Territory or
Self-Governing entity that becomes a Party to the PICTA;
“PICTA” means the Pacific Islands Countries Trade Agreement;
“Tariff Schedule” means the Pacific Harmonized Customs Tariff Schedule
for Niue referred to in the Niue Customs Tariff (General Amendments)
Regulations 1997.

4 Objectives

The objectives of these Regulations is to implement the PICTA by
eliminating trade barriers with –
(i) tariff reduction with retrospective effect as of 1 January 2005;
and
(ii) elimination of tariffs for excepted imports from Small Island
States and Least Developed Countries.

5 Third Schedule inserted

The Tariff Schedule is hereby amended by inserting after the Second
Schedule the following Schedule –

Customs Tariff 165

SCHEDULE 3

Table 1 Elimination and reduction of tariff

Ad valorem tariffs on originating goods which are imported shall be reduced and
eliminated according to the following timetable –

Base tariff on goods on the entry into force of PICTA

Maximum tariff on goods from:

Base tariff on goods on the entry into force of PICTA

1.12.2005

1.1.2007

1.1.2009

1.1.2011

1.1.2013

More than 25%

25%

17.5%

10%

5%

0%

More than 20% but not more than 25%

20%

15%

10%

5%

0%

More than 15% but not more than 20%

15%

10%

5%

0%

More than 10% but not more than 15%

10%

5%

0%

Not more than 10%

5%

0%

Table 2 Elimination on tariffs for excepted imports

Ad valorem tariffs on goods listed by Small Island Countries and Least Developed

Countries as excepted imports shall be eliminated according to the following timetable:

Maximum ad valorem tariffs on goods from:

Entry into force of PICTA

1.1.2007

1.1.2008

1.1.2009

1.1.2010

1.1.2011

1.1.2012

1.1.2013

1.1.2014

1.1.2015

1.1.2016

Base Tariff

50%

40%

35%

30%

25%

20%

15%

10%

5%

0%

166 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

167

DEPARTURE TAX

DEPARTURE TRAVEL TAX REGULATIONS 2002

2002/1 – 15 October 2002

1 Title

These are the Departure Travel Tax Regulations 2002.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Departure Travel Tax Act 1996;
“child” means a person of 2 years of age and up to the age of 12 years;
“diplomat” means any person who has accredited diplomatic status
recognised by the Niue Government;
“infant” means a person under the age of 2 years;
“transit passenger” means a passenger who –
(i) Does not leave the airport or ship; or
(ii) Leaves the airport or vessel only because of an interruption to
the journey caused by the unserviceability of the aircraft or
vessel, or caused by any delay beyond the control of the
passenger or the operator concerned; or
(iii) Stays on Niue solely for the purpose of securing onward travel,
to a country other than the country from which the person
arrived, and departing Niue within 24 hours of arrival;
“vessel” means any boat, ship or yacht.

3 Exemptions

The following are exempt from paying departure tax –
(a) Any member of the crew of a scheduled, military, diplomatic or
licensed commercial aircraft or vessel;
(b) An infant and child;
(c) Any diplomatic staff accredited by the Government of Niue;
(d) A transit passenger.

4 Departure tax charges

(1) All persons departing by aircraft shall pay departure tax at a rate of
$25.00 per person unless exempted under regulation 3.
(2) All persons departing by vessel shall pay departure tax at a rate of
$25.00 per person unless exempted under regulation 3.

168 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

169

DIPLOMATIC PRIVILEGES AND IMMUNITIES

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The various Orders and Regulations made under this Act are not reproduced. The full list of that legislation is in the Table of Subsidiary Legislation.

The Orders and Regulations can be found in Niue Legislation as at 1 August 1990 vol 4 pp314­

355.]

170 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

171

DOGS

DOGS (FEES) REGULATIONS 2005

2005/2 – 24 June 2003

1 Title

These are the Dogs (Fees) Regulations 2005.

2 Fees

The fees prescribed for the purpose of the Dogs Act 1966 are set out in the
Schedule.

––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

Registration Fee

All dogs $20.00
If spayed (with certificate) $10.00
Annual Licence $20.00
Dog collar $10.00

172 Niue wws 2006 Vol 4

173

DOMESTIC FISHING

DOMESTIC FISHING REGULATIONS 1996

1996/1 – 5 March 1996

1

2

3

4

5

6

Title Interpretation Prohibited fish exports Fish size limit

Fish quota limits

Destructive organisms

7

8

9

10

11

12

Protected fish species Vessel safety equipment Annual licence fee for vessels

Vessels fishing inside territorial sea Vessels fishing outside territorial sea Measurements of crustaceans size limits

1 Title

These are the Domestic Fishing Regulations 1996.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Domestic Fishing Act 1995;
“prohibited fish exports” and “protected fish species” when referring to a
species includes a live species, or a dead species, cooked in part or
whole, its bones, meat, teeth or skin;
“vessel” means any boat, or sea craft, or ship whether propelled by oars or
motorised, but does not include –
(a) A canoe;
(b) A yacht not registered in Niue;
(c) A yacht’s tender not used for hire or reward; or
(d) A commercial cargo vessel having a gross tonnage, in excess of five
tonne;
(e) A barge.
(2) Subject to paragraph (1), the expressions defined in the Act have the
meaning so defined.

3 Prohibited fish exports

(1) No person shall export or facilitate the export from Niue of any of the
following species of fish, at any time without written approval of Cabinet –
(a) Turtle (all species);
(b) Sea Snake (all species);
(c) Whale (all species);
174 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(d) Porpoise (all species); (e) Dolphin (all species);
(f) Live tropical fish (all species);
(g) Egg carrying or soft shell crustaceans (all species);
(h) Sea cucumber (all species);
(i) Live sea shells (all species);
(j) Crayfish (all species); and
(k) Rays (all species).
(2) No person shall export or facilitate the export from Niue of the Uga
(Birgus latro) in any form during the period from 1 October to 1 March each year,
without the written approval of Cabinet.

4 Fish size limit

(1) No person shall interfere with, take or kill any fish species that is deemed
under size.
(2) The following fish species are deemed under size, where to measure is
shown under section 12 –
(a) Uga with a thoracic length less than 36mm;
(b) Crayfish with a tail length of less than 130mm;
(c) Clams under 180mm in length;
(d) Tapatapa under 80mm in length.

5 Fish quota limits

(1) No person in a vessel may take or be in possession of more than –
(a) Ten (10) Clams; ] per day per person
(b) Ten (10) Crayfish ] per day per person
(2) Unless the person has obtained a Quota Licence from the Director
approved by Cabinet.

6 Destructive organisms

The following fish species are deemed to be destructive organisms which
cause harm to Niue’s reefs and can be removed from the reef and destroyed –
(a) Crown of Thorns star fish (Acanthaster lanci);
(b) Japanese star fish; and
(c) Long Spined coral boring sea Urchin (Echinoidea Diadema sp.)

7 Protected fish species

(1) No person shall interfere with, take, kill or bring ashore any of the
following fish species at any time without written approval of Cabinet –
(a) Niuean Banded Sea snake;
(b) Large spotted green/brown Moray eel;
(c) Whales (all species);
(d) Porpoise (all species);
(e) Dolphin (all species);
(f) Turtle (all species);
(g) Live Coral (all species);
(h) Egg carrying Crustaceans (all species); and
(i) Soft shell stage Crustaceans (all species);
(j) Giant wrasse;
(k) Rays (all species).
(2) If caught they must be released unharmed.

Domestic Fishing

175

8 Vessel safety equipment

(1) No person shall put to sea in a vessel unless it has the following
equipment on board and in good working condition –
(a) A pair of paddles, or oars and rowlocks, if used in a rowing vessel;
(b) A suitable bailer;
(c) A good fitting drain plug;
(d) A working torch; and a 12 hour cyalume safety-light, or a set of in
date flares;
(e) A suitable light reflecting object;
(f) One standard life preservation jacket or an accepted flotation jacket
for every person board the vessel;
(g) In the case of a vessel powered by a combustion engine, a minimum
“tool kit” containing the following –
(i) plug spanner;
(ii) suitable screwdriver – Phillip or blade type;
(iii) pliers and adjustable spanner;
(iv) spare starter rope; and
(v) a clean set of spark plugs; and
(h) An anchor with a suitable rope or nylon line.
(2) No person shall put to sea in any vessel, less than 4.8 metres (16 foot) in
length unless that vessel complies with all the requirements specified in regulation
8(1).
(3) No person shall put to sea in any vessel 4.8 metres (16 foot) and above in length, unless that vessel complies with –
(a) All the requirements specified in regulation 8(1); and has
(b) A licensed two way communication radio, in good working order;
(c) A spare outboard motor in good working order and be able to be
fitted so that it can operate effectively.
(4) No person shall put to sea in any vessel, carrying visitors, tourists or
other persons for hire or reward unless that vessel complies with –
(a) All the requirements specified in regulation 8(1); and has
(b) A licensed two way communication radio, in good working order;
(c) A spare outboard motor in good working order and be able to be
fitted so that it can operate effectively.

9 Annual licence fee for vessels

(1) No person shall put to sea in any vessel unless the vessel has a current
licence and annual fees in respect of that licence have been paid for that licence
year.
(2) The annual fee shall be as follows –
(a) For a vessel, with a tare weight under 750 kilograms $5.00;
(b) For any vessel that carries persons for hire or reward $50.00;
(c) For a vessel with a tare weight over 750 kilograms $100.00.

10 Vessels fishing inside territorial sea

(1) All fishing vessels operating within Niue territorial sea must comply
with the requirements of the Act and these Regulations.
(2) (a) Cabinet may include additional vessel requirements such as, safety
requirements, verification of registration, certification of the vessel,
and qualification of the skipper.
176 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
fit.
(b) The proven ability of the communications officer to communicate in English as to report their position and fishing catch data and use effectively the communications radio.
(3) Cabinet may impose additional fishing quotas and size limits as it sees

11 Vessels fishing outside territorial sea

(1) All fishing vessels operating outside Niue’s territorial sea must comply
with the requirements of the Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act
1996 and its Regulations.
(2) (a) Cabinet may include additional vessel requirements such as, safety
requirements, verification of registration, certification of the vessel,
and qualifications of the skipper.
(b) The proven ability of the communications officer to communicate
in English as to report their position and fishing catch data and use
effectively the communications radio.

12 Measurement of crustaceans size limits

13 Years Old
RECOMMENDED SMALLEST HUNTING SIZE

This is the smallest size uga that should be hunted. Crabs smaller than this represent the breeding stock of the uga population and should not be taken.
Note: Lobster tails are measured from the posterior side of the calcified bar on the underside of the first segment to the tip of the telson of the tail fan measured in a middle straight line. The points of measurement are as illustrated below –

Domestic Fishing

177

REFERENCE POINTS FOR MEASURING ROCK LOBSTER TAILS

178 Niue W:ws 2006 Vol 4

179

ENTRY, RESIDENCE AND DEPARTURE

ENTRY, RESIDENCE AND DEPARTURE REGULATIONS 1997

1997/2 – 14 January 1997

1 Title 5 Fees payable on issue of permit

2 Interpretation 6 Cabinet review

3 Types of permits 7 Permanent residence status

4 Fees payable on application 8 Certificate of identity

1 Title

These are the Entry, Residence and Departure Regulations 1997.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Entry, Residence and Departure Act 1985;
“business agent” means a person who does not engage in any work in
Niue other than securing orders to import goods into Niue for the
purpose of supply to businesses in Niue;
“entry and residence permit” means a permit to reside in Niue for a period
of up to 36 months but, does not include the right to work;
“exemption permit” means
(a) a permit issued to a person employed by or carrying out consultancy
work for the Government of Niue either with or without
remuneration; and
(b) a permit issued to the spouse and any child or children of any person
qualifying under paragraph (a) provided however that the spouse
and child or children will reside in Niue for a continuous period of
not less than 3 months;
“extension permit” means a permit issued to the holder of either an Entry
and Residence Permit, or a Study Permit, or a Visitor ’s Permit, or a
Work Permit, extending the term in the case of –
(a) An Entry and Residence Permit for a further period not exceeding
36 months;
(b) A Study Permit for a further period not exceeding 36 months;
(c) A Visitor ’s Permit for a further period not exceeding 60 days;
(d) A Work Permit for a further period not exceeding 36 months;
“family” means the spouse of the applicant and any children, by birth or
legal adoption, and under the age of 18 years, of either the applicant or
his spouse;
“holder” in relation to a permit or certificate of identity issued or granted
under the Act or any regulations made thereunder, means the person
in respect of whom the permit or certificate of identity is current; and
in the case of a permit or a certificate of identity issued or granted in
respect of more than 1 person, includes each of those persons;
180 Niue Laws 2005 Vol 4
“Immigration Officer” means a person employed in the Immigration Office as an Immigration Officer;
“permit” means a permit granted under the Act and includes a certificate of identity and all types of permits created by any regulations made under the Act;
“Study Permit” means a permit to undertake study in Niue either at Niue
Primary School, or Niue High School, or any type of training or study
offered at the University of the South Pacific Extension Centre or any
type of apprentice scheme;
“Work Permit” means a permit to undertake a specific type of employment
in Niue for a period of up to 36 months.

3 Types of permits

(1) The following types of permits as defined in regulation may be granted
under section 8, of the Act –
(a) An Entry and Residence Permit;
(b) An Exemption Permit;
(c) An Extension Permit;
(d) A Study Permit;
(e) A Visitor ’s Permit;
(f) A Work Permit.
(2) Should the holder of a Work Permit wish to change the type of
employment specified in the work permit it shall be necessary for such holder to
obtain the prior approval of an Immigration Officer.
(3) On the issue of a Work Permit the Immigration Officer issuing the work
permit shall advise the holder ’s name and address to the Inland Revenue
Department.

4 Fees payable on application

On every application for a permit a fee shall be payable in accordance with
the Schedule. Such fee shall accompany the application for a permit.

5 Fees payable on issue of permit

(1) (a) Subject to paragraphs (2) and (3) on the issue of every permit, a fee
shall be payable under the Schedule.
(b) Such fee shall accompany the application for the permit.
(2) (a) Where an application for a permit is for a period of time less than
that specified for any particular type of permit, the permit fee
payable shall be proportionate to the lesser period of time.
(b) There shall be no refund of the fee payable should the holder of a
permit elect to remain in Niue for a period of time less than that
specified in the permit.
(3) Any person married to or marrying a resident Niuean shall be required
to pay a permit application fee and hold an appropriate permit, provided however,
that person shall be exempt from paying a permit fee.

Entry, Residence and Departure

181

6 Cabinet review

(1) Where the issue of a permit is declined for any reason an application
for review may be made to Cabinet on payment of the fee set out in the Schedule,
provided however, no such application fee shall be payable by a person married
to a Niuean.
(2) Cabinet, after hearing an application for review, may in its discretion
either uphold the decision of the Immigration Officer or direct that a permit issue.

7 Permanent residence status

(1) When an application for permanent residence, as referred to in section
5 of the Act, is granted the grant of permanent residence shall incur a fee as
prescribed in the Schedule.
(2) The fee for granting permanent residence status to a family shall be the
same as the fee for granting permanent resident status to a single person.

8 Certificate of identity

(1) Persons who are not Niuean but are residents of Niue and who do not
possess a valid travel document may be issued with a Niue certificate of identity.
(2) Such certificate of identity may only be issued for the purposes of
facilitating the holders entry into any country accepting Niue certificates of identity.
(3) A fee as prescribed in the Schedule shall be payable on the issue of the
certificate of identity.
(4) The certificate of identity shall be in a form approved by the Immigration
Officer.
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
Exemption permit No charge Visitors permit up to 30 days No charge Application for permanent residence status $20.00
Granting of permanent residence status $500.00
Entry and residence permit for up to 36 months or part $100.00
Work permit up to 36 months or part thereof $300.00
Study permit up to 36 months or part thereof $100.00
Applications for an entry residence, work, or study permit $10.00 each
Cabinet review
Extension permit
Entry and residence up to 36 months or part thereof $50.00
Visitor (for any period up to 30 days) $10.00
Work up to 36 months or part thereof $250.00
Study Permit up to 36 months or part thereof $80.00

182 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

183

ENVIRONMENT

BIOSAFETY (GENETICALLY MODIFIED ORGANISMS) REGULATIONS 2006

2006/4 – 4 July 2006

PART 1

PRELIMINARY

12

Use for food, feed and for processing

1

Short title

13

Development, contained use and testing of

2

Interpretation

genetically modified organisms

3

Objectives

4

The precautionary approach

PART 4

EXEMPTIONS, ENFORCEMENTS AND OFFENCES

PART 2

14

Unintentional releases and transboundary

IMPORTING

movements

Genetically Modified Organisms

15

Illegal releases and transboundary

5

Approval required for import of genetically

movements

modified organisms

16

Offences

6.

Procedure for application to import

17

Dealing with organisms contravening these

genetically modified organisms

Regulations

7

Processing the application

18

Exemptions

8

Deciding the application

9

Review of decisions

PART 5

ADMINISTRATIVE FRAMEWORK

PART 3

19

The role of the Council

OTHER ACTIVITIES RELATING TO GENETICALLY

20

The Department

MODIFIED ORGANISMS

21

The Director

10

Export of genetically modified organisms

11

Transit of genetically modified organisms

SCHEDULE

1 Short title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
These are the Biosafety (Genetically Modified Organisms) Regulations 2006.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Environment Act 2003;
“Advanced Informed Agreement” (AIA) means the procedure prescribed
in Article 7 of the Cartagena Protocol relating to the notification
requirements for transboundary movements of genetically modified
organisms;
“Authority” means the Council;
“biological diversity” has the same meaning as in the Convention on
Biological Diversity;
184 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
“Biosafety Clearing-House” means the Clearing-House established under
Article 20 of the Cartagena Protocol;
“Cartagena Protocol” means the Cartagena Protocol on Biosafety to the
Convention on Biological Diversity adopted at Montreal in January
2000;
“Competent National Authority” has the same meaning as in the Cartagena
Protocol;
“contained use” means any activity, undertaken within a facility, installation
or other physical structure, which involves genetically modified
organisms that are controlled by approved measures to limit their
contact with, and their impact on, the external environment;
“Convention on Biological Diversity””means the 1992 Convention on
Biological Diversity adopted at Nairobi in May 1992;
“Council” means the Environment Council established under section 15 of
the Act;
“Department” means the Environment Department established by section
5 of the Act;
“develop” means genetic modification of a living organism; field testing
or fermentation of a genetically modified organism;
“Director” means the Director for Environment;
“environment officer” means an environment officer appointed under the
Act;
“export” means intentional transboundary movement from Niue to a place
outside Niue;
“exporter” means a person who exports or arranges the export of a
genetically modified organism.
“import” means intentional transboundary movement into Niue from a
place outside Niue;
“importer” means a person who imports or arranges the import of a
genetically modified organism;
“genetically modified organism” has the same meaning as”“living modified
organism” in the Cartagena Protocol; and includes genetically modified
human cells and tissues maintained outside the human body, and
animal cells and tissues maintained in laboratories for research and
investigation;
“living organism” means any biological entity capable of transferring or
replicating genetic material, including sterile organisms, viruses and
viroids;
“micro-organism” means any microbiological entity, cellular or non cellular,
capable of replication or of transferring genetic materials, including
viruses, viroids, human, animal and plant cell in culture;
“Minister” means the Minister responsible for environment matters;
“modern biotechnology” means the application of –
(a) In vitro nucleic acid techniques, including recombinant
deoxyribonucleic acid (DNA) and direct injection of nucleic acid
into cells or organelles;
(b) Fusion of cells beyond taxonomic family, that overcome natural
physiological reproductive or recombination barriers and that are
not techniques used in traditional breeding and selection;
“notifier” means any person giving notification of an intended
transboundary movement of a genetically modified organism;

Environment 185

“Office of External Affairs” means the office responsible for external administrative matters;
“Party” means a Party to the Cartagena Protocol;
“Technical Advisory Group” means any group of technical and/or scientific
experts which is appointed by the Council to assess risks associated
with the application of GMO’s as required in the Regulations and the
NBF;
“transboundary movement” means the movement of genetic modified
organisms from Niue to another State, or from another State to Niue
whether or not that State is a member of the Cartagena Protocol.
(2) Words used in these Regulations, shall have the same meaning as is
given to them in the Convention on Biological Diversity and the Cartagena
Protocol, unless a contrary intention appears.

3 Objectives

The objectives of these Regulations are to –
(a) Protect Niue’s people, environment (including biodiversity) and
culture from the adverse effects of genetically modified organisms;
(b) Facilitate Niue’s economic development by providing for beneficial
uses of genetically modified organisms and modern biotechnology
after appropriate scientific assessment and analysis; and
(c) Provide for public awareness and participation in matters relating
to genetically modified organisms and modern biotechnology.

4 The precautionary approach

(1) All persons exercising functions, powers and duties under these
Regulations shall recognise and provide for the precautionary approach.
(2) For the purposes of paragraph (1), the precautionary approach means
that in the event of threat of harm to the environment or human health, a lack of
scientific certainty regarding the extent of adverse effects shall not be used to
postpone a decision to minimise the potential adverse effects or threat of harm.
PART 2
IMPORTING

Genetically Modified Organisms

5 Approval required for import of genetically modified organisms

No person shall import any genetically modified organism into Niue unless
prior written approval has been given by the Council under these Regulations.

6 Procedure for application to import genetically modified organisms

(1) Every person intending to import a genetically modified organism shall,
before importation, apply to the Council for approval.
(2) The application shall include a risk assessment which shall ­
(a) Be undertaken in a scientifically sound manner taking into account
internationally recognised risk assessment methodologies and
techniques;
(b) Be based upon the information supplied in the application, and
other available scientific evidence to identify and evaluate possible
adverse effects on the environment and risks to human health;
(c) Identify all risks and benefits relevant to the genetically modified
organism.
186 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(3) The application shall be in the form specified in the Schedule and shall be accompanied by the required fee.
(4) An applicant may indicate that certain information is of a confidential nature, if it is information other than –
(a) The name and address of the notifier;
(b) A general description of the genetically modified organism;
(c) A summary of the risk assessment; and
(d) Proposed methods and plans for emergency response.
(5) If the Director is satisfied that the nature of the information justifies it
being kept confidential, the information may only be provided to members of the
Council and Technical Advisory Group, undertaking the relevant risk assessment
and environment officers.
(6) No person to whom the information has been provided under
paragraph (4) may disclose it to any other person, and it may not be used for any
commercial purpose except with the written consent of the notifier.
(7) If the Director is not satisfied that the nature of the information justifies
it being kept confidential –
(a) The notifier shall be advised of the reasons for the decision;
(b) The Director shall consult with the notifier if requested; and
(c) The decision may be reviewed under regulation 9.
(8) Upon receipt of a decision under paragraph (7)(a) the applicant may
withdraw the application and have returned all information, documents and
reports provided in support of the application.

7 Processing the application

(1) (a) The Director shall acknowledge receipt of the application within
90 days.
(b) Failure to acknowledge receipt does not constitute consent to the
importation of the genetically modified organism.
(2) The Director shall notify the application by radio and newspaper, and
invite submissions from the community.
(3) The Council shall review and assess the application and any
submissions.
(4) The Council may at any time ­
(a) Request additional information from the notifier;
(b) Require verification by statutory declaration of any information
provided;
(c) Seek additional information from any source;
(d) Advise the notifier that the time required for the determination of
the matter is to be extended by a stated period;
(e) Defer its decision until costs associated with the application have
been paid.

8 Deciding the application

(1) The Council may approve the development, field testing, contained
use, fermentation or processing of a genetically modified organism if –
(a) There are no adverse effects of the organism; or
(b) There is a demonstrable benefit to Niue; or
(c) The requirements of other applicable laws are sufficient to manage
the risks of the organism; or
(d) The activity is necessary as an emergency response to threats to
human health or the environment.

Environment 187

fit.
(2) The Council may impose such conditions on the approval as it thinks
(3) Any approval given by the Council shall be endorsed by Cabinet before
the activity may be commenced.
(4) The Council shall provide its decision, with reasons, no later than 270
days after considering the application.
(5) An approval given under this regulation may be withdrawn or
suspended by the Council on the grounds that there is a significant risk to the
environment (including biodiversity), or human health.

9 Review of decisions

(1) Any person may request a review of any decision made under these
Regulations, on the grounds that –
(a) A change in circumstances has occurred relating to the risk
assessment on which the decision was based;
(b) Significant additional relevant scientific or technical information
has become available; or
(c) The person is adversely affected by the decision.
(2) The Council shall decide whether to review the decision within 30 days
of receiving the request, and shall –
(a) Give reasons in writing for its decision;
(b) Indicate whether a further risk assessment is to be undertaken.
(3) The Council may decide to review any decision made under these
Regulations on its own motion, and in that event the applicant shall be informed
of the review within 30 days.
(4) (a) The Council may decide to advertise on radio or TV Niue indicating
the request for reviewing of decision.
(b) The Council shall, in exercising its functions under the Act, observe
reasonable standards of procedural fairness, act in a timely fashion
and observe the rules of natural justice, and without prejudice to
the generality of the foregoing, the Council shall –
(i) give to persons who are or who are likely to be affected by
such decision an opportunity to make submissions to and to
be heard by the Council, or otherwise consult with such persons
in good faith;
(ii) have regard to all the evidence adduced and to the matters
contained in any such submissions or otherwise received in
the course of such consultations;
(iii) give a written statement of its reasons for making such a
decision.
(5) No change of decision made under this regulation shall avoid the
requirement to give notice of, or provide risk assessments for, subsequent imports
of the genetically modified organism.
188 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 3
OTHER ACTIVITIES RELATING TO
GENETICALLY MODIFIED ORGANISMS

10 Export of genetically modified organisms

(1) No person shall export a genetically modified organism to any Party
unless –
(a) The export has been notified to and approved by that Party’s
Competent National Authority;
(b) The export complies with any conditions imposed by that Party’s
Competent National Authority.
(c) The Department has been notified of the export.
(2) A notification given under paragraph (1) shall contain –
(a) The information specified in Annex 1 to the Cartagena Protocol;
(b) Any further information required by the Department or the relevant
overseas Competent National Authority.
(3) No genetically modified organism may be exported to a non-Party
without the approval of the Council, which shall take into account the requirements
of these Regulations, and the objectives of the Cartagena Protocol and which has
been endorsed by Cabinet.
(4) A genetically modified organism shall not be exported to a non-Party
until the approval has been endorsed by Cabinet.

11 Transit of genetically modified organisms

No genetically modified organism may be brought into Niue in transit to
any other country unless –
(a) Regulation 6 has been complied with;
(b) Any condition imposed under regulation 6(4)(b) is met; and
(c) The requirements of any law relating to customs and excise,
quarantine and any other relevant matter are complied with.

12 Use for food, feed and for processing

(1) No person may import any genetically modified organism for use as
food, feed or for processing unless –
(a) Regulation 6 has been complied with, if it is being imported into
Niue for the first time; and
(b) All relevant laws regulating its use are complied with.
(2) Where approval is given for the importation of a genetically modified
organism for use as food, feed or for processing under any other Act, and the
organism will be exported from Niue, the Department shall arrange with the Office
of External Affairs;
(a) To notify the Biosafety Clearing-House in accordance with Annex
II of the Cartagena Protocol, within 15 days of an approval for export
being given; and
(b) To give other notifications and information in accordance with
Article 11(1) and (3) of the Cartagena Protocol.

Environment 189

13 Development, contained use and testing of genetically modified organisms

(1) No person shall engage in any activity relating to the development, field testing, contained use, fermentation or processing of a genetically modified organism without prior written approval from the Council.
(2) Any contained use, development, field testing, fermentation or
processing of a genetically modified organism within Niue shall be in accordance
with any condition, requirement or restriction ­
(a) Imposed by the Council; and
(b) Required under any other relevant law.
(3) Applications for approvals under this regulation shall –
(a) Be in an approved form;
(b) Contain such information as is determined by the Director;
(c) Be supported by such further information and verification as may
be required by the Council; and
(d) Be accompanied by the fee set in regulation 19(5)(e).
PART 4
EXEMPTIONS, ENFORCEMENT AND OFFENCES

14 Unintentional releases and transboundary movements

(1) Any person who causes or becomes aware of the unintentional release
or transboundary movement of a genetically modified organism shall immediately
notify the Department and provide such information as the Director may require.
(2) An unintentional release or transboundary movement for the purposes
of this regulation, is one which –
(a) Has not been approved under these Regulations; or
(b) Arises from the breach of a condition of any approval given under
these Regulations.
(3) Upon notification under paragraph (1), the Department shall –
(a) Give notice of the unintentional release or transboundary movement
to –
(i) the members of the Council;
(ii) the Biosafety Clearing-House;
(iii) any affected or potentially affected person; and
(iv) such international organisations which the Director sees fit; and
(b) Consult with any affected or potentially affected country to enable
them to determine appropriate responses, including the taking of
emergency measures.
(4) A notification given under paragraph (3) shall comply with Article 17(3)
of the Cartagena Protocol.

15 Illegal releases and transboundary movements

(1) No person may permit, arrange, assist with, counsel, procure, aid or
abet a release or escape, or transboundary movement of a genetically modified
organism unless in accordance with these Regulations.
(2) In addition to any other penalty imposed for a breach of this regulation,
the person responsible for the breach may be ordered to pay the costs associated
with the disposal of the genetically modified organism, including all costs
associated with its repatriation from or destruction in any country to which it has
been permitted to move.
190

16

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Offences

(1) A person commits an offence shall be liable upon conviction to a fine
not exceeding 1,000 penalty units or to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 10 years, or to both who –
(a) Imports a genetically modified organism into Niue in respect of which no notification has been given as required by regulation 7;
(b) Does not obtain the approval required under regulation 6;
(c) Fails to fully disclose all information known to be relevant to
genetically modified organism in an application relating to it;
(d) Imports a genetically modified organism into Niue without having
an approval required under regulation 8 or 11
(e) Fails to comply with any condition or requirement imposed under
regulation 8;
(f) Fabricates any risk assessment, or misrepresents any matter
associated with a risk assessment undertaken in accordance with
these regulations;
(g) Fabricates or misrepresents any scientific or technical information
relied upon for the purposes of requesting a review of any decision
under regulation 9;
(h) Exports a genetically modified organism in respect of which no
notification has been given as required by regulation 10;
(i) Exports a genetically modified organism without having an
approval required under regulation 10;
(j) Provides any false or misleading information in relation to a
notification of export given in accordance with regulation 10;
(k) Fails to obtain an approval for an activity related to the development,
contained use, field testing, fermentation or processing of a
genetically modified organism in accordance with regulation 13;
(l) Fails to comply with any condition, requirement or restriction
applying to the development, contained use, field testing,
fermentation or processing of a genetically modified organism
under regulation 13;
(m) Undertakes any activity relating to a genetically modified organism
when the approval required under these Regulations is suspended
or has been withdrawn;
(n) Breaches regulation 14 in relation to an unintentional release or
transboundary movement of a genetically modified organism;
(o) Breaches regulation 15 in relation to an illegal release or
transboundary movement of a genetically modified organism; or
(p) Fails to comply with any other obligation or requirement imposed
under these Regulations.
(2) Any person who provides false information in respect of an application
or notification commits an offence and shall be liable upon conviction to a fine not
exceeding 50 penalty units.
(3) Any person who divulges or deals with confidential information
contrary to regulation 6 commits an offence and shall be liable upon conviction to
a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.
(4) In addition to any penalty imposed under this Regulation, an offender
may be ordered to pay to or reimburse the Government the costs of any remedial
action taken or needed to rectify the consequences of any breach.

Environment 191

17 Dealing with genetically modified organisms contravening these

Regulations

(1) For the purposes of enforcing these Regulations, all environment officers
may exercise the powers relating to investigating, monitoring, prosecuting and
preventing the continuation of any breach that are vested in them in any law.
(2) In relation to any genetically modified organism which has been
imported into Niue, or developed, tested, used, released, fermented or processed
in contravention of these Regulations, or which is or remains in Niue in breach of
these Regulations or any condition applying to the organism under these
Regulations, an environment officer may –
(a) Seize the organism;
(b) Destroy the organism as determined by the Council or the Director;
or
(c) Deliver up the organism to an officer of another Department to be
dealt with in accordance with the law.
(3) The cost of destroying any seized genetically modified organism, and
of rectifying any adverse effects from a genetically modified organism as a result
of breach of these Regulations may be recovered as civil debt from any person
making use of the organism in contravention of these Regulations.
(4) Nothing in these Regulations shall affect the powers to search, seize
and deal with items under laws relating to plant and animal quarantine, customs
and excise and any other law that has application to the development, use,
handling, storage or movement of genetically modified organisms.

18 Exemptions

(1) The Council may exempt the importation of a genetically modified
organism from the need for approval if the genetically modified organism is –
(a) To be in transit through Niue;
(b) To be the subject of contained use within Niue;
(c) For direct use as food, feed or for processing;
(d) Agreed by Parties to the Cartagena Protocol to be unlikely to have
adverse effects on biological diversity or pose a risk to human health
or the environment;
(e) Of a type that the Council, with the endorsement of Cabinet, has
determined falls under the scope of any notification given under
Article 13 of the Cartagena Protocol, and if all requirements of other
laws are met in relation to its import into Niue; or
(f) A pharmaceutical for human consumption or emergency animal
treatment that is addressed by other relevant laws or agreements
and subject to the control of other international organisations.
(2) The Director of Health may apply to the Council for an exemption from
the requirement to obtain an approval of any pharmaceutical containing a
genetically modified organism on the grounds of a medical emergency.
(3) When granting an exemption under this regulation, the Council may
impose any conditions or requirements relating to the use, storage, handling or
movement of the genetically modified organism to minimise any impact on the
environment, including biological diversity or human health.
(4) (a) The Council may require the first import of an organism under
regulation 6 (2) to be subject to a risk assessment in accordance
with Annex III of the Cartagena Protocol and decision by the
Council.
192

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

(b) The Council’s decision shall be given in writing not later than 270 days after notification is received.
(c) Failure to make or communicate a decision within 270 days is not consent to the importation of the genetically modified organism.
(5) Exemptions under this regulation shall not take effect until endorsed by Cabinet.
PART 5
ADMINISTRATIVE FRAMEWORK

19 The role of the Council

(1) The Council shall perform the functions of the Competent National
Authority under the Cartagena Protocol.
(2) (a) The Council may appoint a Technical Advisory Group to advise it
in relation to genetically modified organisms and the applications
of modern biotechnology.
(b) The functions of the Technical Advisory Group may include –
(i) considering and reporting on any application made under these
Regulations, including applications to review decisions;
(ii) considering and reporting on any other matter relating to the
use of genetically modified organisms in Niue;
(iii) investigating any matter relating to the implementation of the
Cartagena Protocol in Niue; and
(iv) recommending policies in relation to genetically modified
organisms and the applications of modern biotechnology in
Niue.
(3) The Council shall –
(a) Oversee implementation of the requirements of the Cartagena
Protocol, including the Advanced Informed Agreement Procedure
(AIA);
(b) Establish appropriate and cost effective means for undertaking risk
assessments, including determining–
(i) the appropriate bodies within Niue or elsewhere to undertake
the risk assessments;
(ii) the scope of risk assessments and the methodologies to be
applied; and
(iii) the cost of risk assessments, and the persons liable to pay these
costs.
(c) Make decisions under these Regulations, including –
(i) exempting certain genetically modified organisms from the
requirements of Part I (Article 13 of the Cartagena Protocol;)
and
(ii) reviewing decisions (Article 12 of the Cartagena Protocol;)
(d) approve any forms required to implement these Regulations,
(e) set fees for processing applications under these Regulations.
(6) The Council may develop policies, standards and procedures in relation
to these Regulations including –
(i) monitoring the development, field testing, fermentation,
release, use, handling and transboundary movement of
genetically modified organisms within Niue, and other matters
related to the application of modern biotechnology;
(ii) risk assessment and risk management applying to any aspect
of the development, field testing, fermentation, release, use,

Environment 193

handling and transboundary movement of genetically modified organisms within Niue, and other matters related to the application of modern biotechnology;
(iii) identification and evaluation of adverse effects associated with genetic modification and the introduction of genetically modified organisms into Niue;
(iv) containment standards to be applied to any authorised use, development, field testing or release of a genetically modified organism;
(v) responding to unintentional and unlawful transboundary movements;
(f) In developing such policies, standards and procedures, the Council
shall take into account ­
(i) the impacts of genetically modified organisms on communities
and areas within Niue;
(ii) the customs and traditions of Niue.

20 The Department

(1) The Department shall be the National Focal Point for all purpose
associated with the Cartagena Protocol.
(2) For the purposes of these Regulations the Department may –
(a) Provide secretariat and support services to the Council and any
advisory committee;
(b) Deal with requests for the review of decisions in accordance with
Article 12 of the Cartagena Protocol, and refer such matters to the
Council with such reports and additional information as required;
(c) Arrange for certain information to be treated as confidential in
accordance with these Regulations and the Cartagena Protocol;
(d) Conduct programs of public awareness and education in relation
to genetically modified organisms and applications of modern
biotechnology, and facilitating public participation in relation to
the processes prescribed by these Regulations and envisaged by
the Cartagena Protocol in relation to their use and development
within Niue;
(e) Liaise with other Departments and agencies, and work
collaboratively with them to –
(i) establish and maintain appropriate mechanisms, measures and
strategies for the regulation, management and control of risks
associated with genetically modified organisms and the
application of modern biotechnology within Niue;
(ii) implement measures to control and prevent unintentional and
illegal transboundary movements of genetically modified
organisms, and to respond to such movements, including the
taking of necessary emergency responses;
(iii) ensure that genetically modified organisms which are subject
to transboundary movement are handled, packaged and
transported under conditions of safety, and that relevant
international standards and rules are applied in this regard;
(iv) ensure that genetically modified organisms within Niue, or
proposed to be imported into Niue, are packaged and labelled
so as to disclose their genetically modified organism content,
and otherwise identified as being or containing genetically
194 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
modified organisms as required by any law and by the
Cartagena Protocol; and
(v) facilitate the development and strengthening of human
resources and institutional capacities within Niue in the field
of biosafety; and
(f) Facilitate appropriate bilateral, regional and multilateral agreements
and arrangements regarding intentional transboundary movements
of genetically modified organisms, and for the sharing of
information and the enhancement of institutional capacities for the
purposes of applying the provisions of the Cartagena Protocol.

21 The Director

(1) For the purposes of these Regulations, the Director may –
(a) Approve the provision of assistance and support to the Council
and advisory committees;
(b) Require further information to be provided under the Advanced
Informed Agreement Procedure;
(c) Make arrangements for the keeping of certain information
confidential in accordance with the provisions of these Regulations
and the Cartagena Protocol;
(d) Prepare information and reports required by the Cartagena Protocol;
(e) Arrange for the monitoring and reporting of the effects to the
environment and on human health arising from genetically
modified organisms and the application of modern biotechnology
within Niue;
(f) Approve and implement any appropriate program of public
information and education concerning genetically modified
organisms and the implementation of the Cartagena Protocol; and
(g) Do any other act or thing necessary to manage the risks and
maximise the benefits associated with genetically modified
organisms and the application of modern biotechnology within
Niue.
(2) The powers of the Director shall be exercised consistently with decisions
of the Council.
———————————————

SCHEDULE

NOTIFICATION OF TRANSBOUNDARY MOVEMENT OF A GENETICALLY

MODIFIED ORGANISM TO NIUE

Annex 1 of Cartagena Protocol

1 Name, address, telephone and facsimile numbers and email address of ­

(a) Notifier

(b) Exporter

(c) Importer(s)

(state the nature of the relationship between the notifier and the exporter or importer)

2 Name and identity of the LMO

(a) Domestic classification

(b) Biosafety Level of LMO in the state of export

Environment 195

3 Purpose of the transboundary movement to Niue

(a) Import for release

(b) Import for contained use

(c) Transit through the Niue (if so, give full details of destination and other

relevant approvals)

(d) Direct use for food, feed or for processing

(Give full details of proposed purpose and means of release, contained use, transit or use

as food, feed or for processing.)

4 Intended date/s and means of transboundary movement ­

5 Taxonomic status

(a) Common name

(b) Point of collection

(c) Characteristics recipient organism/or parental organism

6 Centres of origin ­

(Describe the habitats where the organisms may persist)

7 Describe the nucleic acid or the modification introduced ­

(a) What was the modification technique used for the development of
the organism?
(b) What are the resulting characteristics of the genetically modified
organism?

8 Give full details of the intended use of the Genetically Modified Organism.

9 Give full details of the quantity and volume of LMO to be transferred.

10 Has your organisation undertaken a risk assessment of the transferred LMO? (Attach any available report and all supporting information and data)

11 Give full details of proposed method(s) for – (a) safe handling

(b) storage

(c) transport and use

(d) packaging and labeling

(f) monitoring and reporting on effects

(g) disposal and emergency procedures

12 Regulatory status of LMO within the country of export

(State any reason for any previous rejection of approval or ban of the LMO, and

give full details of any breaches of any relevant law in another jurisdiction, or any criminal

prosecution under such law)

13 Purpose, status and outcome of any notification by the exporter to any other country.

14 State or provide any other information known to the notifier, importer or exporter that is relevant to this application.

I ...................................................................declare that all the above information is correct.

........................................... ...........................................

Signature Date

196 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

197

EXTRADITION

[EDITORIAL NOTE: A list of orders relating to extradition and fugitive offenders is provided in the Table of Subsidiary Legislation.]

198 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

199

FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT

FILM AND PUBLIC ENTERTAINMENT (FEES) REGULATIONS

2005

2005/3 – 24 June 2003

1 Title

These are the Film and Public Entertainment (Fees) Regulations 2005.

2 Fees

The fees prescribed for the purpose of the Film and Public Entertainment
Act 1979 are set out in the Schedule.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

Public Entertainment Premises Annual Licence $100.00

Dance Permit (per function) $10.00

Dance Permit beyond midnight (per function) $15.00

200 Niue Laws 2006 Vol4

201

GENERAL LAWS

MARITIME SECURITY REGULATIONS 2004

2004/2 – 1 July 2004

9 Port organisation and responsibility

10 Port Facility Operator ’s responsibility

11 Other port users

12 Shipping organisation and responsibility

1 Title

These are the Marine Security Regulations 2004.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“authorised person” means a person with powers and duties under these
Regulations;
“Committee” means the Maritime Security Committee established under
regulation 5;
“company” means the owner or operator of a vessel to which these
Regulations apply;
“Company security officer” means the person designated by the company
for ensuring that a ship security assessment is carried out; that a ship
security plan is developed, submitted for approval, and thereafter
implemented and maintained and for liaison with port facility security
officers and the ship security officer;
“Contracting Government” includes the Port Authority;
“Convention” means the International Convention for the Safety of Life at
Sea, 1974 and its amendments (SOLAS);
“deadweight tonnage” means the total load of cargo, fuel, stores and ballast
that a ship can carry;
“Department” means the department of Government with particular
responsibility for Port Services and Shipping;
202 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
“disallowed item” means –
(a) any thing made or altered for use for causing bodily injury or
intended by the person who has the article for such use, any article
capable of being used for causing bodily injury, any anaesthetising
or other substance produced for use for disabling persons or
intended by the person who the substance for such use, and
(b) any thing capable of destroying or causing damage to or
endangering the safety of a ship, port or port facility or persons on
a ship or at a port or port facility, and
(c) any thing likely to destroy or cause damage to or endanger the
safety of a ship, port or port facility or persons on a ship or at a port
or port facility;
“gross registered tonnage” means the total capacity of a vessel in tonnage
units of 100 cubic feet;
“exclusion zone” means a waterside area to which access is temporarily
restricted to persons authorised by the Ports Authority;
“facility operator” means port facility to which these Regulations apply;
“ISPS Code” means the International Ship and Port Facility Security Code;
“master” means a person having command or charge of a ship;
“Maritime Security Committee” means the Committee constituted under
regulation 5;
“Minister” means the Minister responsible for National Security;
“Niue port” means a port in Niue that service ships engaged on
international voyages;
“Niue ship” means a ship that is registered in Niue;
“Port Authority” means the Port Authority or the agency of the Executive
Government of Niue responsible for the administration, management
and operation of Niue ports and is, for the purposes of the ISPS Code,
the Designated Authority;
“port facility” means the ship/port interface facility that provides for the
interactions that occur when a ship is directly and immediately affected
by actions involving the movement of persons, goods or the provisions
of port services to or from the ship;
“port facility operator” means the manager of ship/port interface facility
that provides for the interactions that occur when a ship is directly and
immediately affected by actions involving the movement of persons,
goods or the provisions of port services to or from the ship;
“port facility security officer” means a suitably qualified person designated
by the facility operator responsible for the development,
implementation, review and maintenance of the Port Facility Security
Plan and for liaison with ship security officers, the company security
officer and the port security officer;
“Port Facility Security Plan” means a plan developed to ensure the
application of measures designed to protect any or all of the port facility
and ships, persons, cargo, cargo transport units and ship’s stores within
the port facility from the risks of a security incident;
“Port Security Plan” means a plan developed to ensure the application of
measures designed to protect any of the port facilities of Niue or all of
the port, and ships, persons, cargo, cargo transport units and ship’s
stores within those port facilities or ports from the risks of a security
incident and incorporates all port facility security plants;

General Laws 203

“Port security officer (PSO)” means a person designated as such by the port authority;
“restricted areas” means areas on a ship to which access is restricted to crew, persons invited by the master or ship security officer and persons authorised pursuant to these regulations;
“restricted zone” means landside areas to which access is restricted to
persons authorised by the facility operator or persons authorised
pursuant to these regulations;
“screener” means a person, approved by the PSO, who conducts screening
procedures;
“screening procedures” means those measures involved in the inspection
of people and goods, and the checking for disallowed items;
“Security Level 1” means the level for which minimum appropriate
protective security measures shall be maintained at all times;
“Security Level 2” means the level for which appropriate additional
protective security measures shall be maintained for a period of time
as a result of heightened risk of a security incident;
“Security Level 3” means the level for which further specific protective
security measures shall be maintained for a limited period of time when
a security incident is probable or imminent, although it may not be
possible to identify the specific target;
“Ship Security Officer” means the person on board a ship, accountable to
the master, designated by the Company as responsible for the security
of the ship, who shall perform those duties stipulated in the ISPS Code,
including implementation and maintenance of the SSP, and liaison with
the CSO and PSOs;
“Ship Security Plan” means a plan developed to ensure the application of
measures on board the ship designed to protect persons on board, cargo,
cargo transport units, ship’s stores or the ship from the risks of a security
incident;
“sterile area” means an area of the port approved pursuant to these
Regulations in which persons, vehicles and goods are not permitted
until given clearance by an authorised person;
“unaccompanied baggage” means any baggage, including personal effects,
which is not with the passenger or member of ship’s personnel at the
point of screening;
“unlawful interference” includes without lawful excuse –
(a) Seizing, or exercising control of, a ship by force, or threat of force,
or any other form of intimidation;
(b) Damaging or destroying a ship that is in service;
(c) Placing, or causing to be placed, on board a ship in service a thing
that is likely to –
(i) destroy the ship; or
(ii) endanger its safety;
(d) Communicating information, which is known to be false, thereby
endangering the safety of a ship;
(e) Committing an act of violence against a person, property or the
environment at a port, if the act –
(i) causes, or is likely to cause, injury or death; and
(ii) endangers, or is likely to endanger, the safe and efficient
operation of the port or the safety of anyone at the port;
(f) Attempting to commit an act described in any of the above
paragraphs.
204 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(2) Terms not otherwise defined in this part shall have the same meaning as the meaning attributed to them in SOLAS.
(3) The following acronyms mean – CSO Company Security Officer DWT Dead Weight Tonnage
GRT Gross Registered Tonnage
ISPS Code International Ship and Port Facility Security Code
MSC Maritime Security Committee
PFO Port Facility Officer
PFSA Port Facility Security Assessment
PFSO Port Facility Security Officer
PFSP Port Facility Security Plan
PSA Port Security Assessment
PSO Port Security Officer
PSP Port Security Plan
RSO Registered Security Organization
SSA Ship Security Assessment
SSO Ship Security Officer
SSP Ship Security Plan

3 Application

These Regulations apply to —
(a) Niue ships;
(b) Niue ports and port facilities; and
(c) All foreign vessels in Niue’s waters to which the Convention applies;
(d) Fishing vessels 12 metres in length and above fishing in the EEZ of
Niue and international waters.

4 Port Security Officer’s duties

The PSO is responsible for –
(a) Initiating, developing, promoting and reviewing maritime security
policy, legislation, standards and procedures;
(b) Auditing and pursuing compliance with maritime security policy,
legislation, standards and procedures;
(c) Preparing Port Security Plans;
(d) Drawing up and maintaining a list of vulnerable points of the ports,
including essential equipment/facilities and review their security
from time to time;
(e) Promote security awareness amongst port workers/users and
shipowners;
(f) Coordinating the maritime security policy response to a threat or
act, which threatens the security of the maritime transport sector;
(g) Coordinating the provision of intelligence and information on
threats to the maritime industry;
(h) Facilitating the development, implementation, review and
maintenance of the port security plan and liaison with port facility
security offices and ship security officers, where appropriate;
(i) In consultation with PFSOs, ensuring that appropriate security
measures are maintained at the port;
(j) Maintaining and supervising the implementation of the PSP,
including any amendments to the PSP;
(k) Proposing modifications to the PSP;

General Laws 205

(l) Reporting to the Committee any deficiencies and non conformities identified during internal audits, periodic reviews, security inspections and verifications of compliance and implementing any corrective actions;
(m) Attending meetings of the Committee;
(n) Enhancing security awareness and vigilance by all staff;
(o) Ensuring adequate security training has been provided to port
employees and agents with regard to their security roles and
responsibilities and maintenance of training records;
(p) Ensuring that security equipment is appropriately operated, tested,
calibrated and maintained;
(q) Ensuring effective communication and cooperation between the
port and members of the port security committee;
(r) Reporting all security incidents to the Committee; and
(s) Overseeing the issue of copies of the PSP and maintaining a record
of all authorised holders;
(t) Ensuring compliance with the PSP and the implementation of
complementary additional security measures as required by the
Committee;
(u) The PSO shall initiate periodic internal audits or reviews of the PSP
to ensure compliance with, and appropriateness of, existing security
measures.

5 Maritime Security Committee

(1) The Maritime Security Committee is established for the purposes of
maritime security of Niue.
(2) The Committee shall be appointed by Cabinet.
(3) The Chair of the Committee shall be appointed by Cabinet.
(4) The role of the Committee shall be to –
(a) Coordinate the implementation of national maritime security
measures in Niue ports and on Niue ships;
(b) Provide a forum for the discussion of maritime security matters
affecting port tenants/users and ships visiting the ports;
(c) Provide a forum for communication between port tenants/users
and shipowners on issues of security and procedures in place to
meet threats, providing for normal situations and contingencies for
periods of heightened tension and emergency situations;
(d) Liaise, as considered appropriate, with external agencies to discuss
security issues;
(e) Provide advice on maritime security to the Committee, industry
and the public; and
(f) Advise the Committee of the need for additional security measures.
(5) The PSO shall ensure that a record of each meeting is kept and minutes
are forwarded within one month of the meeting, either in written or electronic
form, to all committee members.
(6) In the event of a security incident the PSO or shipowner must contact
the Chair of the Committee who shall immediately convene a meeting of the
Committee, along with other members as determined appropriate, who may set
up a support team.
(7) The role of the support team under paragraph (6) is to –
(a) Provide technical and operational advice and assistance to the police
in relation to operational matters and resources available at the port;
206 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(b) Consult with the police, ensure the orderly conduct of other operations on the port not associated with the incident; and
(c) Provide incident-related advice and information to their respective organisations and the Committee.

6 Security levels

(1) Cabinet shall, when necessary, and with the recommendation of the
Committee, set security levels and provide guidance for protection from security
incidents.
(2) Higher security levels indicate greater likelihood of occurrence of a
security incident.
(3) Factors to be considered in setting the appropriate security level
include –
(a) The degree that the threat information is credible;
(b) The degree that the threat information is corroborated;
(c) The degree that the threat information is specific or imminent; and
(d) The potential consequences of such a security incident.
(4) Cabinet shall, when necessary, with the recommendation of the
Committee, issue appropriate instructions and shall provide security related
information to the ships and port facilities that may be affected.
(5) Additional security measures may be implemented either at the
direction of the PSO or on the initiative of the Port Authority or the ship owner
who shall give immediately advise the PSO.
(6) The Committee may delegate as appropriate certain duties under these
Regulations other than –
(a) Setting of the applicable security level;
(b) Approving a PSA/PFSA/SSA and subsequent amendments to an
approved assessment;
(c) Determining the port facilities that will be required to designate a
PFSO;
(d) Approving a PSP/PFSP/SSP and subsequent amendments to an
approved plan.

7 Declaration of Security

(1) A Declaration of Security must be completed in respect of a port or
port facility when Cabinet deems it necessary or when a master deems it necessary.
(2) A Declaration of Security records the agreement reached between the
ship and the port facility or with other ships with which it interfaces as to the
respective security measures each will undertake in accordance with the provisions
of their respective approved security plans.
(3) The need for a Declaration of Security may be indicated –
(a) By the PSO or PFSO;
(b) By the results of the PFSA or PSA;
(c) By the Maritime Administration of the flag state of a ship, or
(d) By the result of a SSA.
(4) A ship can request a Declaration of Security when –
(a) The ship is operating at a higher security level than the port facility
or another ship it is interfacing with;
(b) There is an agreement on a Declaration of Security between
Contracting Governments covering certain international voyages
or specific ships on those voyages;

General Laws 207

(c) There has been a security threat or a security incident involving the ship or involving the port facility, as applicable;
(d) The ship is at a port that is not required to have and implement an approved port facility security plan; or
(e) The ship is conducting ship-to-ship activities with another ship not required to have and implement an approved SSP.
(5) If a ship, or a Maritime Administration on behalf of ships entitled to fly its flag, requests completion of a Declaration of Security, the PSO and SSO should acknowledge the request and discuss appropriate security measures.
(6) The Declaration of Security should be signed and dated by both the PSO and the master of SSO on behalf of the ship, as applicable, to indicate compliance with SOLAS chapter XI-2 and Part A of the ISPS Code and states its duration, the relevant security level and the relevant contact details.
(7) The Declaration of Security shall be completed in English and in the form prescribed in Schedule 8.

8 Port Security Plan

(1) The Committee shall under these Regulations conduct a PSA and
produce a PSP, issued under the authority of Cabinet.
(2) The PSO shall prepare the Draft PSP and the Committee may approve
its content prior to its circulation to those offices or persons approved by the
Committee and shall approve all amendments prior to their being put into effect.
(3) The PSO may amend the PSP as necessary, subject to approval by the
MSC.
(4) The completed PSP is classified “Confidential” and, while selected
members of staff will need to be appraised of particular aspects of the Plan, it shall be protected from unauthorised access or disclosure.
(5) No part of the PSP may be reproduced or transmitted, in any form or by any means, without the written consent of the Committee.

9 Port organisation and responsibility

(1) All employees and agents of the Port Authority whose duties require
them to implement security controls at the port or routinely access a restricted
zone at the port must ensure that the protective security arrangements covered by
the PSP are observed at all times.
(2) Any employee or agent on becoming aware of a –
(a) Breach or suspected breach of security arrangements;
(b) Any deficiency in the PSP; or
(c) Who observes activities of a suspicious nature;
must report the matter immediately to the PSO.
(3) The Port Authority shall appoint a PSO who, with the authority of management, shall administer the day-to-day operations of the PSP at the port.

10 Port Facility Operator’s responsibility

(1) The Port Facility Operator shall, in co-operation with the Committee
and in accordance with these Regulations, conduct a PFSA and produce a PFSP,
issued under the authority of PSO.
(2) The PFSP shall be incorporated into the overall PSP where appropriate.
(3) The PSO shall review the draft PFSP and may approve its content prior
to its circulation and shall approve all amendments prior to their being put into
effect.
208 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(4) The PSO may amend the PSP as necessary, subject to approval by the
Committee.
(5) Port Facility Operators, lessees and tenants are responsible for –
(a) The security of their facilities and areas specifically allocated for
their use;
(b) Maintaining access control procedures as they apply to any of their
facilities; and
(c) Ensuring that any staff or other persons such as contractors, who
enter restricted zones or sterile areas do so only on current essential
duties related to that area;
which would be effected through contractual arrangements.
(6) Port Facility Operators, lessees and tenants may be required, at short
notice from the Port Authority or the PSO, to comply with security systems and/
or procedure variations resulting from increases in maritime security threats.
(7) Security exercises, to test measures and response arrangements, shall
be conducted by the PSO at a frequency agreed with the Committee.
(8) The object of the exercises is to not only test response arrangements to
a simulated act of unlawful interference but also to –
(a) Practice call out of all involved elements;
(b) Test the adequacy of facilities;
(c) Exercise members of the port security committee in the provision
of effective support to police operational elements; and
(d) Test the adequacy of appropriate contingency plans.
(9) The PSO and appropriate PSFOs will review each security exercise and
submit a formal report to the Committee, within one month of the completion of
the exercise.

11 Other port users

Any person who enters the port is required to comply with all regulatory
provisions brought to their notice by any means including public notices, signs,
announcements, publications or oral messages.

12 Shipping organisation and responsibility

(1) The Company shall ensure compliance with the SSP and for the
implementation of complementary additional security measures as required by
the Committee.
(2) The Company shall initiate periodic internal audits or reviews of the
SSP to ensure compliance with, and appropriateness of, existing security measures.
(3) The Company shall appoint a CSO, who, with the authority of
management, shall administer the overall operations of the SSP on all the
Company’s ships.
(4) The Company shall appoint a SSO for each ship, who, with the authority
of management, shall administer the day-to-day operations of the SSP on each of
the Company’s ships.
(5) The duties and responsibilities of the CSO shall include –
(a) Advising the level of threats likely to be encountered by the ship,
using appropriate security assessments and other relevant
information;
(b) Ensuring that ship security assessments are carried out and
regularly reviewed;
(c) Ensuring the development, the submission for approval, and
thereafter the implementation and maintenance of the SSP;

General Laws 209

(d) Ensuring that the SSP is amended, as appropriate, to correct perceived shortcomings and satisfy the security requirements of the individual ship;
(e) Arranging for internal audits and reviews of security activities;
(f) Ensuring that deficiencies and non-conformities identified during
internal audits, periodic reviews, security inspections and
verifications of compliance are promptly addressed and dealt with;
(g) Enhancing security awareness and vigilance;
(h) Ensuring adequate training for personnel responsible for the
security of the ship;
(i) Ensuring effective communication and cooperation between the
SSO and the relevant PFSOs and the PSO;
(j) Ensuring consistency between security requirements and safety
requirements;
(k) Ensuring that, if sister-ship or fleet security plans are used, the plan
for each ship reflects the ship-specific information accurately;
(l) Ensuring that any alternative or equivalent arrangements approved
for a particular ship or group of ships are implemented and
maintained; and
(m) Authorising the issue of copies of the SSP and maintaining a record
of all authorised holders.
(6) The duties and responsibilities of the SSO include –
(a) Undertaking regular security inspections of the ship to ensure that
appropriate security measures are maintained;
(b) Maintaining and supervising the implementation of the SSP,
including any amendments to the SSP;
(c) Coordinating the security aspects of the handling of cargo and ship’s
stores with other shipboard personnel and with the relevant PFSOs;
(d) Proposing modifications to the SSP;
(e) Reporting to the CSO any deficiencies and non conformities
identified during internal audits, periodic reviews, security
inspections and verifications of compliance and implementing any
corrective actions;
(f) Enhancing security awareness and vigilance on board;
(g) Ensuring adequate training has been provided to shipboard
personnel with regard to their security roles and responsibilities
and maintenance of training records;
(h) Reporting all security incidents;
(i) Coordinating implementation of the SSP with the CSO and the
relevant PFSO; and
(j) Ensuring that security equipment is properly operated, tested,
calibrated and maintained.
(7) All employees and agents of the company, including crew, must ensure
that the protective security arrangements covered by the SSP are observed at all
times. Any employee or agent becoming aware of a –
(a) Breach or suspected breach of security arrangements;
(b) Any deficiency in the SSP; or
(c) Who observes activities of a suspicious nature;
must report the matter immediately to the CSO or SSO as appropriate.
(8) Nothing in these Regulations removes from the master the overriding
authority and responsibility to make decisions with respect to the safety and
security of the ship and to request the assistance of the Company or of any
government as may be necessary.
210 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

13 Ship Security Plans

(1) Companies owning ships that are operating in Niue waters shall, in
accordance with these Regulations and following discussion with the Committee,
conduct a SSA and produce a SSP, issued under the authority of CSO.
(2) The PSO shall review the Draft SSP and the Committee may approve
its content prior to its circulation to those offices and persons approved by the
Committee and shall approve all amendments prior to their being put into effect.
(3) The CSO may amend the Plan as necessary, subject to approval by the
Committee.
(4) The completed SSP is classified “Confidential” and, while company
staff and ship’s crew will need to be appraised of particular aspects of the SSP, it
shall be protected from unauthorised access or disclosure.
(5) No part of the SSP may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by
any means, without the written consent of the CSO.
(6) The CSO may, at any time, review the SSP and in reviewing the SSP the
CSO may have regard to –
(a) Developments in relation to human and other resources used and
procedures followed concerning ship security; and
(b) Experience gained in relation to ship security by other ship
operators.
(7) If the CSO is satisfied that –
(a) The approved SSP is no longer adequate for any one or more of the
SSP purposes; or
(b) The effectiveness of the SSP for those purposes could be
substantially improved;
the CSO should prepare and submit to the Committee for approval, proposals for
any variation of the SSP considered necessary.

14 Contingency Procedures – ports

(1) In the event of an employee or agent of the Port Authority or Port Facility
Operator becoming aware of a significant act of unlawful interference or an
unlawful threat, that person shall report the incident threat as soon as practicable
to the PSO.
(2) Where the incident/threat directly impacts upon another organisation,
or may impact upon one or other organisations, the PSO is to relay details of the
incident threat to the organisation(s) concerned as soon as possible.
(3) The assessing and classifying of all threats, such as bomb or sabotage
threats, against any of the port’s amenities rests with the Committee, whereas
assessing and classifying threats against a Port Facility Operator ’s amenities rests
with the agency concerned.
(4) Threats are to be classified as either “GENUINE”, in which case
appropriate response procedures are to be instigated and followed, or “HOAX”,
in which case no further action (other than to report the incident to the police and
the PSO) is required.
(5) Where the search of a building or facility (over which the Port Authority
or Port Facility Operator has management control) is considered necessary, the
threat shall be considered to remain genuine until the PSO advises that the threat
has been reclassified as a hoax, or any suspicious object discovered during the
search has been removed or declared safe.
(6) The PSO will report to the police details of significant breaches of
security or threats impacting upon the operations of the Port Authority or Port
Facility Operator involving violence.

General Laws 211

(7) The PSO is to report, at the earliest opportunity, all security related incidents as well as actual or suspected acts of terrorism impacting upon the operations of the Port Authority or Port Facility Operator such as –
(a) Discovery of weapons or disallowed items within the port or Port
Facility;
(b) Unauthorised access to restricted areas;
(c) Unauthorised access to a ship;
(d) Bomb or sabotage threats;
(e) Disruptive and/or abusive passengers or stevedores; and
(f) Incidents that have attracted media attention
to the Committee.
(8) Contingency procedures shall be developed and maintained to provide
for situations that could present a threat to the security of the port or Port Facility.
(9) These procedures shall form part of the PSP or PFSP.
(10) Other types of emergencies that should be provided in the PSP or
PFSP include –
(a) Bomb search routine;
(b) Evacuation procedures;
(c) Security equipment failure; and
(d) Action to be taken in respect of a major security incident at the
port.
(11)Where it may not be possible to provide a full report within a reasonable
time frame, due to the need to investigate certain aspects, a preliminary report
shall be forwarded.
(12) The type of information that the PSO should include in any report
to the Department is detailed at Schedule 6.

15 Contingency Procedures – ships

(1) In the event of any person becoming aware of an act of unlawful
interference on board a ship at sea or in port or an unlawful threat, that person shall report details of it as soon as practicable to the master, SSO or CSO as appropriate.
(2) Where the incident or threat directly impacts upon or may impact upon another organisation, the master or CSO must relay details of the incident/threat to the other organisation as soon as possible.
(3) The duty of assessing and classifying of all threats, such as bomb or sabotage threats, against the ship or other facilities rests with the Company.
(4) Threats are to be classified as either “GENUINE”, in which case
appropriate response procedures are to be instigated and followed, or “HOAX”,
in which case no further action (other than to report the incident to the local police
and the PSO) is required.
(5) Where the search is considered necessary, the threat shall be considered
to remain genuine until the master or CSO advises that the threat has been
reclassified as a hoax, or any suspicious object discovered during the search has
been removed or declared safe.
(6) The master or CSO will report to the local police details of significant
breaches of security or threats impacting upon the operations of the ship involving
violence.
(7) The master or CSO shall report, at the earliest opportunity, all incidents
as well as actual or suspected acts of terrorism or other acts of unlawful interference
that may affect the security of the ship, such as –
212

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

(a) Discovery of weapons or disallowed items aboard the ship; (b) Unauthorised access to restricted areas;
(c) Unauthorised access to the ship; (d) Bomb or sabotage threats;
(e) Disruptive and/or abusive passengers; and
(f) Incidents that have attracted media attention
to the Committee.
(8) Contingency procedures shall be developed and maintained to provide
for situations that could present a threat to the security of the ship and shall form
part of the SSP.
(9) Other types of emergencies that should be provided in the SSP include –
(a) Bomb search routine in port;
(b) Bomb search routine at sea
(c) Repelling unsolicited boarders at sea;
(d) Evacuation of the vessel;
(e) Security equipment failure; and
(f) Security procedures while in dry-dock or extended maintenance.
(10) Where it may not be possible to provide a full report within a reasonable
time frame, due to the need to investigate certain aspects, a preliminary report
shall be forwarded.
(11)The type of information that the SSO should include in any report to
the CSO is detailed at Schedule 7. Upon receipt of the report the CSO shall forward
a copy to the Department, which may contain supplementary information.

16 Security training – ports

(1) Responsibility for developing and maintaining the security awareness
and training of the Ports Authority’s employees and agents rests with the PSO
and the Committee.
(2) The PSO and the Committee shall ensure that relevant employees and
agents of the Ports Authority are provided with a basic level of training, the object
of which is to establish a rudimentary level of security awareness. The minimum
level of training shall include the following –
(a) Port layout and organisations;
(b) The role of the Port Authority, the PSO, Police and other government
agencies;
(c) Basic port security procedures;
(d) Access control;
(e) Threat response; and
(f) Other training specific to their duties.
(3) The Committee through the PSO shall ensure that employees and agents
of the Ports Authority engaged in port security activities undertake more advanced
training, which as a minimum shall include –
(a) Principles of protective maritime security;
(b) Legislation;
(c) IMO standards;
(d) Law enforcement interface;
(e) Passenger and baggage screening (where applicable);
(f) Bomb threat assessment; and
(g) Search and evacuation guidelines.
(4) The training modules offered shall be reviewed periodically, as shall
the need for refresher training, with regard being given to developments in
equipment used and procedures.

General Laws 213

(5) The PSO shall ensure that records on the content, duration and dates of those training activities undertaken by employees and agents of the Ports Authority are retained for the previous five years.
(6) Port Facility Security Training is the responsibility of the Port Facility Operator who shall develop and maintain security awareness and training of its employees and agents, and shall follow as closely as possible the procedures required to be followed by the Port Authority for the ports in paragraphs (1) to (4)

17 Security Training – ships

(1) The Company will ensure that all crew are provided with sufficient
training to enable them to understand and carry out their security responsibilities.
(2) Training will consist of initial training in procedures and practices
applicable to their position and, as appropriate, refresher training, which takes
into account developments in relation to the equipment used and procedures
followed relative to maritime security.
(3) The Company shall ensure that records of the content, duration and
dates of those training activities undertaken by crewmembers are retained for the
previous 5 years.
(4) Crew must be provided with current travel advice information prepared
by the Office of External Affairs for those foreign ports they are to operate to or
from and the potential impact that any special port security procedures in place
may have.

18 Police powers

In addition to the powers and responsibilities set out in these Regulations
and in any other enactment in relation to the management and enforcement of
maritime security, any constable shall have all the powers necessary for the proper
enforcement of these Regulations.

19 Offences

(1) Any person who contravenes or fails to comply with these Regulations,
or the directions of an authorised person acting under these Regulations, commits
an offence.
(2) Any person who possesses a disallowed item commits an offence.
(3) Any person who commits an act of unlawful interference commits an
offence.

20 Penalties

A person who commits an offence under these Regulations is liable on
conviction to a fine not exceeding 100 penalty units or a term of imprisonment not
exceeding 12 months.

21 Forms

Forms to be used as those set out in Schedules 1 to 8.
––––––––––––––––––––
214 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Form of the International Ship Security Certificate

NIUE

INTERNATIONAL SHIP SECURITY CERTIFICATE

(Official seal) (State) Certificate Number.............................................

Issued under the provisions of the INTERNATIONAL CODE FOR THE SECURITY OF SHIPS AND OF PORT FACILITIES (ISPS CODE)

Under the authority of the Government of Niue by the Minister of National Security

Name of ship: ............................................................................................................................... Distinctive number or letters: .................................................................................................... Port of registry: ............................................................................................................................. Type of ship: ................................................................................................................................. Gross tonnage: .............................................................................................................................. IMO Number: ............................................................................................................................... Name and address of the Company: ........................................................................................

THIS IS TO CERTIFY:

1 That the security system and any associated security equipment of the ship has

been verified in accordance with section 19.1 of Part A of the ISPS Code.

2 That the verification showed that the security system and any associated security

equipment of the ship is in all respects satisfactory and that the ship complies with the

applicable requirements of chapter X1-2 of the Convention and Part A of the ISPS Code.

3 That the ship is provided with an approved Ship Security Plan.

Date of initial/renewal verification on which this certificate is based ................................ This Certificate is valid until ...................................................................................................... subject to verifications in accordance with section 19.1.1 of Part A of the ISPS Code.

Issued at Alofi by the Secretary to .................................................................... Government

(signature)

Issued on the.............day of ....................................20.................(Seal or Stamp)

General Laws 215

ENDORSEMENT FOR INTERMEDIATE VERIFICATION

THIS IS TO CERTIFY that at an intermediate verification required by section 19.1.1 of part A of the ISPS Code the ship was found to comply with the relevant provisions of chapter X1-2 of the Convention and Part A of the ISPS Code.

Intermediate verification - Signed ...........................................................

(Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

ENDORSEMENT FOR ADDITIONAL VERIFICATIONS*

Additional verification - Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

Additional verification - Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

Additional verification - Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

*This part of the certificate shall be adapted by the Maritime Administration/Port Authority to indicate whether it has established additional verifications as provided for in section 19.1.1.4.

216 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

ADDITIONAL VERIFICATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH SECTION A/193.7.2 OF THE ISPS CODE

THIS IS TO CERTIFY that at an additional verification required by section 19.3.7.2 of Part A of the ISPS Code the ship was found to comply with the relevant provisions of chapter X1-2 of the Convention and Part A of the ISPS Code.

Additional verification - Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

ENDORSEMENT TO EXTEND THE CERTIFICATE IF VALID FOR LESS THAN 5 YEARS WHERE SECTION A/19.3.3 OF THE ISPS CODE APPLIES

The ship complies with the relevant provisions of Part A of the ISPS Code, and the Certificate shall, in accordance with section 19.3.3 of Part A of the ISPS Code, be accepted as valid until the...........................day of...................20 ...............

Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

ENDORSEMENT WHERE THE RENEWAL VERIFICATION HAS BEEN COMPLETED AND SECTION A/19.3.4 OF THE ISPS CODE APPLIES

The ship complies with the relevant provisions of Part A of the ISPS Code, and the Certificate shall, in accordance with section 19.3.4 of Part A of the ISPS Code, be accepted as valid until the...........................day of...................20 ...............

Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

General Laws 217

ENDORSEMENT TO EXTEND THE VALIDITY OF THE CERTIFICATE UNTIL REACHING THE PORT OF VERIFICATION WHERE SECTION A/19.3.5 OF THE ISPS CODE APPLIES OR FOR A PERIOD OF GRACE WHERE SECTION A/19.3.6 OF THE ISPS CODE APPLIES

This Certificate shall, in accordance with section 19.3.5 19.3.6* of Part A of the ISPS Code, be accepted as valid until the...........................day of...................20...............

Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

ENDORSEMENT FOR ADVANCEMENT OF EXPIRY DATE WHERE SECTION A/19.3.71 OF THE ISPS CODE APPLIES

In accordance with section 19.3.7.1 part A of the ISPC Code, the new expiry date** is the

.......................day of..............20............

Signed ...........................................................

(Signature of Secretary to Government)

At Alofi on the.......................day of..............20............

(Seal or Stamp or the authority, as appropriate)

*Delete as appropriate.

**In case of completion of this part of the certificate the expiry date shown on the front of

the certificate shall also be amended accordingly.

––––––––––––––––––

218 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULE 2

Form of the INTERIM International Ship Security Certificate

NIUE

INTERIM INTERNATIONAL SHIP SECURITY CERTIFICATE

(Official seal) (State)

Certificate Number .....................................................................................................................

Issued under the provisions of the

INTERNATIONAL CODE FOR THE SECURITY OF SHIPS

AND OF PORT FACILITIES (ISPS CODE)

Under the authority of the Government of Niue by the Minister of National Security

Name of ship: ............................................................................................................................... Distinctive number or letters: .................................................................................................... Port of registry: ............................................................................................................................. Type of ship: ................................................................................................................................. Gross tonnage: .............................................................................................................................. IMO Number: ............................................................................................................................... Name and address of the Company: ........................................................................................

Is this a subsequent, consecutive interim certificate? Yes No*

If Yes, date of issue of initial interim certificate .......................................................................

THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT the requirements of section A 19.4.2 of the ISPS Code have been complied with.

This Certificate is issued pursuant to section A/19.4 of the ISPS Code.

Date of initial/renewal verification on which this certificate is based ................................ This Certificate is valid until ......................................................................................................

subject to verifications in accordance with section 19.1.1 of Part A of the ISPS Code.

Issued at Alofi by the Secretary to Government (signature) Issued on .........................................day of..............20............ (Seal or Stamp)

*Delete as appropriate

––––––––––––––––––––––

General Laws 219

SCHEDULE 3

Form of the International Ship Security Certificate

NIUE

STATEMENT OF COMPLIANCE OF A PORT OR PORT FACILITY

(Official seal) (State)

Certificate Number .....................................................................................................................

Issued under the provisions of the INTERNATIONAL CODE FOR THE SECURITY OF SHIPS AND OF PORT FACILITIES (ISPS CODE)

Under the authority of the Government of Niue by the Minister of National Security

Name of Facility: .......................................................................................................................... Address: ........................................................................................................................................ Telephone: ......................................................... Fax: ................................................................ Chief Executive Officer ................................... Email .............................................................

Port Facility Security Officer and Contact Details

Harbour Master ................................................ Email ............................................................. Telephone .......................................................... FaxMobile ..................................................... THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT the requirements of the provisions of SOLAS Chapter X1-2

and Part A of the ISPS Code have been complied with

Date of initial/renewal verification on which this certificate is based ................................ This Certificate is valid until ...................................................................................................... Issued at Alofi by the Secretary to Government .................................................. (signature) Issued on the the .........................................day of..............20............ (Seal or Stamp)

––––––––––––––––––––––

220 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULE 4

GUIDELINES FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF PORT AND PORT FACILITY SECURITY PLANS

The following is for the guidance of ship owners and operators of ships to whom these

Regulations apply.

1 Facility Access Control Measures

(1) Peripheral protection of the restricted zone is provided by intrusion protection

and detection equipment. It is normally achieved by installing security barriers (fencing),

which can be complemented by installing peripheral or close intrusion detection

equipment and/or intrusion display equipment. Openings in security barriers should be

kept to a minimum and secured when not in use. Security barriers should accomplish the

following –

(a) Define the area to be protected;

(b) Create a physical and psychological deterrent to persons attempting or

contemplating unauthorised entry;

(c) Delay intrusion, enabling operating personnel and security guards to

detect and apprehend intruders; and

(d) Provide designated and readily identifiable places for entry of personnel

and vehicles into areas where access is controlled.

(2) Where feasible, buildings and other suitable permanent obstacles should be

used as part of the physical barrier, provided that access through the buildings used is

controlled. If buildings are used as part of the security barrier, they should be inspected

to ensure that windows, roofs, ventilation openings, etc., do not provide for unauthorised

access, with consideration being given to the fitting of bars, grills or screens.

2 Access Control Measures – Staff

Only those employees/agents who have a legitimate need to access the facility

operator ’s restricted zone shall enter the area. Other staff members will need to justify a

need for access to the PFSO.

3 Access Control Measures – Service Providers & Visitors

(1) Where a service provider, such as a maintenance contractor or a ship’s

providor, requires access to a restricted zone their need to access the area shall be verified

with the requesting organisation.

(2) Where that need can be established the person(s) may be authorised to enter

the restricted zone. However, where the need cannot be established the person is to be

denied entry and the matter brought to the attention of the PFSO, who in turn may consider

it appropriate to inform the police.

(3) Visitors with a legitimate requirement for access to a restricted zone shall

remain under supervision by their sponsor at all times during the visit.

(4) The identify of each non-employee/non-agent provided access to the restricted

zone is to be recorded, for each visit, in a visitor ’s register. The minimum detail to be

recorded shall comprise their name, organisation represented, arrival time, departure

time, who sponsored their visit. The register is to also show the signature of the person

authorising their access to the restricted zone.

(5) Records of those persons authorised to access the restricted zone will be

retained by the PFSO for a period of twelve months.

4 Access Control Systems

(1) Where access points into the restricted zone are key-controlled a restricted

key system is to be used.

(2) Keys will only be issued, by the PFSO, to authorised persons (e.g. staff and

regular contractors) who have a valid reason to access to the restricted zone in the course

of their duties.

General Laws 221

(3) A key register will be maintained detailing to whom specific keys have been issued as well as the date of issue and return (where appropriate). Recipients are to sign the register for each key issued.

(4) Change of coding should be considered where control of any key is lost. Coding must be changed when 5% or more of the keys to any particular lock cannot be accounted for.

(5) Where an electronic access control system is fitted access rights will only be provided, by the PFSO, to authorised persons who have a valid reason to access the restricted zone in the course of their duties.

(6) A register of those with access rights will be maintained detailing to whom specific rights have been provided as well as the date granted, date withdrawn (where appropriate), the areas into which the holder has access and any prohibitions that may apply (e.g. access limited to certain hours).

(7) The PFSO shall audit bi-annually the manual and electronic systems registers and ensure that any deficiencies are rectified within one month of the audit.

(8) Keys and access cards, or changes to access cards, will only be effected where the applicant has requested the issue change in writing and the request is approved by their supervisor/manager.

5 Electronic Surveillance

Enhanced surveillance over specific facilities/installations or specific areas may

be determined essential to guard against a perceived threat and could involve the use of the following types of equipment: CCTV or intruder detection systems.

––––––––––––––––––––––

222 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULE 5

GUIDELINES FOR THE DEVELOPMENT OF SHIP SECURITY PLANS

The following is for the guidance of ship owners and operators of ships to whom these

Regulations apply.

1 Restricted areas

(1) Ship Security Plans shall show the following –

(a) The location of restricted areas, (e.g. bridge, engine room, steering gear

compartments, officers’ cabins and crew accommodation);

(b) The location and function of actual or potential access points (e.g. ladders,

gangways, scuttles, mooring lines and cranes); and

(c) Spaces with security and surveillance equipment, cargo spaces, spaces

containing ship’s stores or hazardous substances.

(2) A sign advising those areas that are restricted to authorised personnel shall

be prominently displayed on those doors providing initial access to each restricted area.

These signs will be maintained in good condition and be clearly legible.

2 Access control

(1) It is Company policy that all entrances to the ship are closed unless the master

decides there are operational reasons to have one or more of these open. All open access

points must be protected to the same standard.

(2) The master should consider all operational and potential security impacts

when deciding how many gangways are rigged at each port. This decision should consider

the Security Level and allocation of crew for security surveillance activities.

(3) While in port no shell door will be opened under any circumstances without

the express permission of the Officer on Watch. At sea, no shell door will be opened

without permission of the master. Where a shell door is to remain open a member of crew

shall be placed on guard duty to prohibit unauthorised entry.

(4) All doors allowing access to restricted areas shall be secured (where

practicable), controlled and regularly inspected. The intention is to establish secure areas

that unauthorised persons will find difficult to penetrate while being cognisant of other

requirements such as the need to provide for emergency egress.

(5) Where an access point is via a gangway, ramp or ladder and is used at night,

the area surrounding that access point shall be adequately illuminated.

(6) All persons, other than crew, proposing to board the ship will need to have a

justifiable reason to access the ship prior to entry being authorised.

(7) Crewmembers shall challenge all persons, other than authorised crew, in a

restricted area should the person not be displaying an appropriate form of company

identification or the person is not under escort by another member of the crew.

(8) The identity of those persons authorised the access a restricted area shall be

recorded, for each visit, in a visitor ’s register. The minimum detail to be recorded shall

comprise their name, organisation represented, arrival time, departure time, who

sponsored their visit. The register is to also show the signature of the person authorising

their access to the restricted area.

(9) Records of those persons authorised to access the restricted area will be

retained by the SSO for a period of twelve months.

(10) Visitors, other than service providers such as an accredited maintenance

contractor or ship’s providor, with a legitimate requirement to access a restricted area

shall remain under supervision of the SSO, or someone nominated by the SSO, while

within a restricted area.

3 Access Control Systems

(1) Where access points into the restricted area are key-controlled a restricted

key system is to be used.

(2) Keys will only be issued, by the SSO, to crewmembers who have a valid reason

to access to the restricted area in the course of their duties.

General Laws 223

(3) A key register will be maintained detailing to whom specific keys have been issued as well as the date of issue and date of return (where appropriate). Recipients are to sign the register for each key issued.

(4) Where an electronic access control system is fitted access rights will only be provided, by the SSO, to crewmembers who have a valid reason to access the restricted area in the course of their duties.

(5) A register of those with access rights will be maintained detailing to whom specific rights have been provided as well as the date granted, date withdrawn (where appropriate), the areas into which the holder has access and any prohibitions that may apply (e.g. access limited to certain hours).

(6) The SSO shall audit bi-annually the manual and electronic systems registers and ensure that any deficiencies are rectified within an agreed timeframe, which shall be as soon as practicable.

(7) Keys and access cards, or changes to access cards, will only be effected where the applicant has requested the issue change in writing and the request is approved by their supervisor/manager.

4 Restricted Area Breach

(1) In the event of a detected breach of security in a restricted area the SSO will

arrange for the incident to be investigated and a sweep of the affected area will be

conducted. The purpose of the sweep will be to determine the method of unauthorised

access, check for evidence of tampering to commodities, etc., and locate any suspicious

objects prior to the recommencement of operations in the area.

(2) In each case those security measures and procedures breached will be re­

evaluated with the view to remedying any inherent or perceived weaknesses.

5 Screening of Passengers and their Baggage

(1) On each occasion that a prospective passenger presents for boarding the

company will ensure that –

(a) The passenger has valid travel documentation;

(b) Baggage is only accepted from ticketed passengers;

(c) Baggage is only accepted at a designated check-in point;

(d) A tag displaying the relevant passenger ’s name and the total number of

items checked in, at that time, by that passenger is securely attached to

each item of baggage accepted for carriage; and

(e) Prior to the baggage being loaded, baggage accepted for carriage will not

be accessible by a person other than person authorised by the port facility

operator or company, the owner of the item (once they have been

screened), and those involved in loading the item aboard the ship.

(2) The company will ensure that all passengers and their possessions are, prior

to their entering any sterile area used for departing passengers, subject to screening

procedures by an approved screener unless specifically exempted pursuant to the

Department’s maritime security regulations.

(3) The company will ensure that the sterile area into which the screened

passengers pass is an area properly secured against unauthorised entry and exit.

(4) Where there is no sterile area the company will ensure that all passengers

and their possessions are, prior to their being provided access to the ship, subject to

screening procedures by an approved screener unless specifically exempted pursuant to

the Department’s maritime security regulations.

(5) The company will ensure that passengers, or intending passengers, of the

ship who have been screened do not make physical contact with persons, vehicles or

goods that have not been screened or cleared for purposes of maritime security unless

the persons, vehicles or goods are specifically exempted pursuant to the Department’s

maritime security regulations.

(6) When a weapon or other disallowed item is detected during the screening

process it must be surrendered if the passenger wishes to travel. Surrendered weapons or

disallowed items may be carried aboard the ship in a secure manner and returned to the

passenger at his or her destination point.

224 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

(7) An approved screener must not screen a passenger, other than by a physical search, should the passenger elect to be screened by means of a physical search.

(8) The tag attached to unaccompanied baggage is to be checked prior to the baggage being loaded aboard the ship. Any accompanied baggage that is not tagged shall not be loaded until the legitimacy of the baggage can be verified by the SSO.

(9) Strict control shall be exercised over tags used to identify authorised baggage to limit the likelihood of rogue bags being introduced into the baggage stream.

(10) When in an overseas port, prior to allowing any passengers and their baggage aboard, the SSO/CSO will need to be satisfied that security measures, in relation to the handling of passengers and their baggage are consistent with the ISPS Code.

and providors), and goods in their possession will be screened should they board the ship via an active passengers screening point, unless specifically exempted pursuant to the Department’s maritime security regulations.

(2) Crew, guests of crew and service providers who enter the ship via an alternate means, separate from the sterile area, need not be subject to screening.

8 Crew Baggage

(1) Until baggage is checked in or taken aboard the ship, crewmembers are at all

times responsible for the security integrity of their baggage.

(2) Where crew baggage is consolidated prior to check-in or being stowed aboard

the ship, the baggage is to be kept under constant surveillance by a crewmember or other

authorised person.

9 Cargo Handling

(1) Cargo accepted for export (from Niue) shall be in accordance with Niue

Customs Service requirements. This recognises that all goods for export come under

Customs control and also recognises the established preventive security measures, both

physical and procedural, that Niue Customs Service has in place with regard to those

goods.

(2) Prior to loading packaged and containerised export or domestic cargo the cargo is to undergo a cursory inspection to ensure that there are no obvious signs of tampering.

(3) Any obvious signs of tampering or damage must be referred to the SSO and the cargo handler. If a satisfactory explanation cannot be established the cargo shall not be accepted. Should there be a satisfactory reason for the loss of integrity then the damage shall be made good before acceptance.

(4) The SSO shall contact the local police or the Australian Customs Service in suspicious circumstances.

(5) For both export and domestic cargo, where a cargo handler (e.g. stevedore) who is challenged by a crewmember is unable to produce appropriate identification then the goods shall not be accepted.

(6) When the ship is in an overseas port, prior to accepting goods the SSO/CSO will need to be satisfied that security measures, in relation to the handling of cargo, are consistent with the ISPS Code.

10 Ship’s Stores

(7) All stores are to be individually accepted by a member of the ship’s crew,

with evidence that they were ordered made available prior to their being loaded aboard

the ship.

(8) Prior to acceptance, the goods are to undergo a cursory inspection by crew to

ensure that there are no obvious signs of tampering.

General Laws 225

(9) Any signs of obvious tampering or damage must be referred to the SSO and the port facility operator/transporter. If a satisfactory explanation cannot be established the goods are not to be accepted. Should there be a satisfactory reason for the loss of integrity then the damage shall be made good before acceptance.

(10) For passenger ships, and where X-ray equipment is in use, the stores should (where possible) be “broken down” and screened via the use of the X-ray equipment, which is to be operated by an approved screener.

(11) For passenger ships, where X-ray equipment is not available, or the item is too large to fit through the frame of the X-ray equipment, those stores are to be subject to a detailed physical search by approved screeners.

(12) In a limited number of cases those screening the stores may be satisfied that the goods do not contain a weapon or disallowed item, based on other considerations, such as the surrounding circumstances of the arrival of the goods at the ship. For example, the goods are transported within a pre-existing and secure scheme known to the screener.

––––––––––––––––––––––

226 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULE 6

THREAT/INCIDENT REPORT PORT OR PORT FACILITY

General information

Name of Port/Facility: ................................................................................................................ Person providing Report: ........................................................................................................... Date: ................................ Time: ............................... Location: ..................................................

Type of occurrrence (e.g. bomb/sabotage threat, unauthorised entry, suspect device, extortion, etc)

........................................................................................................................................................

Description of threat/incident

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

Alleged offender(s)

Name: .................................................................... Nationality: ................................................ Name: .................................................................... Nationality: ................................................ Name: .................................................................... Nationality: ................................................ Name: .................................................................... Nationality: ................................................

Nature and severity of any injuries sustained by others

Name: ............................................... link to port: ................................. Injury: ....................... Name: ............................................... link to port: ................................. Injury: ....................... Name: ............................................... link to port: ................................. Injury: ....................... Name: ............................................... link to port: ................................. Injury: .......................

General Laws 227

Circumstances surrounding device(s) used

Type of Device(s): ........................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................ Method of introduction (e.g. passenger, baggage, cargo, stores, etc): .................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................ Security measures circumvented: ..............................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................ Proposed measures and procedures to prevent recurrence of a similar event?

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................ Other pertinent details

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................ Reporting Officer

Signature ................................................................ Name (printed): .........................................

Designation: ........................................................... Date: ............................................................

Upon receipt of this report the PSO shall forward a copy to the Department.

––––––––––––––––––––––

228 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULE 7

THREAT/INCIDENT REPORT SHIP

General information

Name of Ship: ............................................................................................................................... Person providing Report: ........................................................................................................... Date: ................................ Time: ............................... Location: ..................................................

Type of occurrence (eg bomb/sabotage threat, unauthorised entry, passenger incident, suspect device, etc)

........................................................................................................................................................

Description of threat/incident

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

........................................................................................................................................................

Alleged offender(s)

No. Passengers: ...................... No. Crew: ............................... Other: ..................................... Name: ...................................... Nationality: ............................ Embarked: ............................. Name: ...................................... Nationality: ............................ Embarked: ............................. Name: ...................................... Nationality: ............................ Embarked: ............................. Name: ...................................... Nationality: ............................ Embarked: .............................

General Laws 229

Nature and severity of any injuries sustained by passengers, crew or others

Name: ...................................... Crew/Pass/Other: ................ Injury: .................................... Name: ...................................... Crew/Pass/Other: ................ Injury: .................................... Name: ...................................... Crew/Pass/Other: ................ Injury: .................................... Name: ...................................... Crew/Pass/Other: ................ Injury: .................................... Circumstances surrounding device(s) used

Type of Device(s): .......................................................................................................................

....................................................................................................................................................... Method of introduction (e.g. passenger, baggage, cargo, stores, etc): ................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

....................................................................................................................................................... Security measures circumvented: .............................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

Proposed measures and procedures to prevent recurrence of a similar event?

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

230 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

.......................................................................................................................................................

.......................................................................................................................................................

Reporting Officer

Signature ................................................................ Name (printed): ........................................ Designation: ........................................................... Date: ...........................................................

Upon receipt of this report the CSO shall forward a copy to the Department.

––––––––––––––––––––––

General Laws 231

SCHEDULE 8

Form of a Declaration of Security between a ship and a port facility* DECLARATION OF SECURITY

Name of Ship:

Port of Registry:

IMO Number:

Name of Port Facility:

This Declaration of Security is valid from..................until.......................for the following activities

.......................................................................................................................................................

............................................................................... (list the activities with relevant details)

under the following security levels

Security level(s) for the ship:

Security level(s) for the port facility:

The port facility and ship agree to the following security measures and responsibilities to ensure compliance with the requirements of Part A of the International Code for the Security of Ships and of Port Facilities.

232 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

The affixing of the initials of the SSO or PFSO under these columns indicates that the activity will be done, in accordance with relevant approved plan, by:

Activity

The port facility

The ship

Ensuring the performance

of all security duties

Monitoring restricted areas to ensure that only authorised personnel have access

Controlling access to the port

facility

Controlling access to the ship

Monitoring of the port facility, including berthing

areas and areas

surrounding the ship

Monitoring of the ship, including berthing areas and areas surrounding the ship

Handling of cargo

Delivery of ship’s stores

*This form of Declaration of Security is for use between a ship and a port facility. If the

Declaration of Security is to cover two ships this model should be appropriately modified.

233

INCORPORATED SOCIETIES

open to the public for the transaction of business daily (except on Saturdays and holidays), during such hours as the Registrar of Incorporated Societies fixes from time to time, either generally or in any particular case.
(2) In this regulation ‘holiday’ includes –
(a) Any day falling during the period commencing on 25 December
and ending with 2 January;
(b) Where 2 January falls on a Saturday, the 4th day of January;
(c) Where 2 January falls on a Sunday, the 3rd and 4th days of January.
(3) Every day which is a holiday in relation to any instrument or document
that is required to be registered with the Assistant Registrar, be deemed to be a
holiday within the meaning of section 5 of the Interpretation Act 2004.

5 The matters to be recorded in the Register in respect of every society shall be –

(i) A distinctive registration number; (ii) The name of the society;
(iii) The date of registration of the society;
(iv) The situation of the registered office of the society for the time
being, and the date on which every notice of the situation of
that office is given to the Registrar;
(v) The date on which any annual statement under section 23 of
the Act is delivered to the Registrar, and an indication of the
end of the financial year of the society to which the statement
relates;
(vi) The fact of the dissolution of the society, and the date of any
declaration of dissolution made under section 28 of the Act;
(vii) Any revocation of a declaration of dissolution, and the date of
the entry in the Register;
(viii) The nature of any other document relating to the society
lawfully lodged with the Registrar under the Act, and the date
when it was so lodged.
234 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

6 Wherever by the Act attestation by a witness is required, the witness shall after his signature add his calling or description and place of abode.

7 Wherever by the act it is required that the seal of the Registrar be affixed to any document, the Registrar shall verify the sealing by appending his signature and the date on which the seal was so affixed.

8 On payment of the prescribed fee for an application for registration or alteration of rules (as the case may be) the Registrar may peruse any proposed rules or alteration of rules signed by the secretary or other principal officer of the society, although such rules or alteration of rules may not yet have been enacted by the society, but such rules or alteration of rules shall not be registered until duly enacted and verified as required by the Act.

9 A voluntary winding-up of a society shall be deemed to commence at the time of the confirmation pursuant to section 24 of the Act of the resolution for voluntary winding up.

10 Upon confirmation of a resolution for voluntary winding up, the society in general meeting shall appoint one or more liquidators for the purpose of winding up the affairs and distributing the assets of the society, and may fix the remuneration to be paid to him or them.

11 In the application to the voluntary winding-up of a society pursuant to section 24 of the Act of the rules relating to the voluntary winding-up of a company, these rules shall apply as if such winding up were a members’ voluntary winding up under the Companies Act.

12 (1) (a) All documents prepared to be registered, or to be delivered, sent, or forwarded to the Registrar must be legibly and clearly written, typewritten, or printed on paper of foolscap size and of medium weight and good quality, with a margin of at least one-fourth of the width of the paper.

(b) Where there are more sheets than one, they must be fastened together with a sufficient paper fastener at the top left-hand corner.
(2) Carbon copies shall not be received by the Registrar.
(3) Except by special leave of the Registrar, granted upon such conditions
as he thinks fit, no document shall be received by the Registrar which does not
comply with this regulation.

13 (1) There shall be paid to the Registrar, in respect of the matters mentioned in the Schedule, the fees specified.

(2) Where the Registrar or any other officer is empowered by the Act to do any act for which a fee is payable, he may refuse to do that act until the fee is paid.

––––––––––––––––––––––

Incorporated Societies

SCHEDULE

FEES PAYABLE TO REGISTRAR

235

$

On application for registration 10.00

For alteration of rules 2.00

For registration of new rules in place of registered rules 5.00

For a certified copy of or extract from the register or any

Document lodged with the Registrar, for each half sheet of

Foolscap or part of such a half sheet 1.00

236 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

237

LIQUOR

LIQUOR (BREWERIES) REGULATIONS 1992

1992/2 – 22 September 1992

1 Title

These are the Liquor (Breweries) Regulations 1993.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
PART 1
INTERPRETATION
“beer” includes ale porter, stout and any other description of beer, and any liquor which is made as a description of beer or and which on analysis is found to be of a strength exceeding 2 parts per cent proof spirit;
“brewery” or “brewery premises” means any premises –
(a) On which is carried on the manufacture or preparation of beer for
sale; or
(b) On which is carried on the casking or bottling of beer for sale other
than retail sale;
“Inspector” means an Inspector of Health appointed under section 7 of the
Public Health Act 1965, and includes a Medical Officer.
PART 2
BREWERY PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT

3 Brewery premises

(1) (a) All brewery premises shall be well constructed in accordance with
law, and kept in good repair.
(b) As far as may be practicable they shall offer no entrance or
harbourage for rodents or insects.
(2) Without limiting the generality of paragraph (1), all brewery premises
shall comply with the requirements set out in the Schedule.

4 Brewery ingredients and containers

No person shall carry on brewing, except under the following
requirements –
(a) Suitable storage space shall be provided for all ingredients used in
the preparation of beer, and those ingredients shall be effectively
protected from contamination; and
(b) No bottle, barrel, jar, vat or other container, used for containing
beer, shall be filled with beer unless the container is clean and free
from foreign matter; and
238 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(c) No spent hops or other wastes shall be kept longer than necessary on any premises used for the manufacture of beer; and
(d) All spent hops and other wastes shall be removed from the premises at regular and frequent intervals; and
(e) All tasting glasses and other appliances and vessels used for the sampling of beer shall, when not in use, be stored in a dustproof place, and shall be thoroughly cleaned immediately on every occasion after being used.

5 Brewery equipment

No person shall carry on a brewery, except under the following
requirements –
(a) All corks, crown seals, wads, and capping devices, that may come
into contact with beer when used in closing or sealing any beer
container, shall be clean and new and until so used shall be kept in
such a manner as to be protected from contamination; and
(b) All jars, bottles, glasses and other beer containers, shall be effectively
cleaned and rendered hygienic before use; and
(c) All equipment, conveyors, storage casks, and vats shall be situated
so as to provide easy access for cleaning and washing down; and
(d) All movable storage vessels and equipment shall be supported
above floor level so as to facilitate cleaning and keeping of the floor
free from dampness; and
(e) All beer hoses shall be made from high grade rubber or from any
other non-toxic material, and shall be in a sound condition; and
(f) No defective beer hose shall be permitted to remain on the premises;
and
(g) All beer hoses shall be cleaned and rendered hygienic at least once
each week; and immediately after cleaning all beer hoses shall be
drained and shall until they are next used, be kept uncoiled in such
a manner that they remain free from liquid and are protected from
contamination; and
(h) All buckets, cans, chutes, valves, fittings, pipes, tubes and other
similar appliances, through which beer is passed, shall be made of
stainless steel or of any other material approved by an Inspector,
and
(i) All valves, fittings, and pipelines, through which beer is passed,
shall –
(i) Be cleaned and rendered hygienic at least once each week; and
(ii) Until they are next used, be kept in such a manner that they are
protected from contamination; and
(iii) Be constructed so that they can be easily dismantled for
inspection and cleaning; and
(j) All valves, fittings, and pipelines, through which beer is passed,
shall be dismantled for cleaning, except where they are so arranged
that cleaning and bactericidal or hot water solutions can be
circulated throughout the fixed system to contact all interior
surfaces, and that system is self-draining and can be completely
evacuated; and
(k) Every tap or pipe, used for the drawing of beer for sale, shall be
constructed in such a manner –

Liquor 239

(i) As to permit the ready cleaning of all internal parts; and
(ii) As to be properly sealed to prevent leakage; and
(iii) That the whole of the interior surface is perfectly smooth and
free from undulations and irregularities, and is of stainless steel
or of any other material approved by an Inspector throughout
its length.

6 Water

Water used for brewing shall be clear and free of impurities, and if necessary,
filtered or treated in a manner approved by an Inspector so as to render it clear
and free of impurities and fit for wholesome construction.

7 Beer not to be syphoned by mouth

No person engaged in a brewery in the manufacture, preparation, casking
or bottling of beer for sale shall apply to his mouth any syphon tube from a vessel
containing beer.

8 Closure of premises

PART 3
GENERAL PROVISIONS
(1) Where any brewery premises are, by reason of their situation, construction, disrepair or state, in such a condition that any beer in the premises may be exposed to contamination or taint, to deteriorate or become dirty, an Inspector may serve a notice in writing on the occupier of the premises requiring him –
(a) To clean, reconstruct, or repair the premises in a manner to be specified in the notice, within a period (not being less than 14 days) to be specified in the notice; or
(b) To clean, reconstruct, or repair the premises in a manner to be
specified in the notice, and to cease to use the premises as brewery
premises until the cleaning, reconstruction or repair has been
completed to the satisfaction of an Inspector; or
(c) To cease to use the premises as brewery premises, and not to
subsequently resume the use of the premises as brewery premises.
(2) Any notice served under paragraph (1) may be revoked at any time by
an Inspector. The occupier of the premises to which the notice related shall
forthwith be notified in writing of the revocation.
(3) The fact that a notice has been served under paragraph (1) shall not
prevent the service of another notice under any paragraph of that subclause in
respect of the same premises.
(4) A notice under paragraph (1) shall have effect notwithstanding that
the time for filing an appeal under regulation 10 in respect of the notice has not
expired, or that such an appeal has been filed but has not been determined, unless
an Inspector suspends the operation of the notice until the time for filing such an
appeal has expired or until any appeal so filed has been determined.
(5) It shall be sufficient compliance with a notice under paragraph (1)
requiring the occupier of food premises to clean, reconstruct, or repair any premises,
if the occupier ceases to use the premises as brewery premises and does not
subsequently resume the use of the premises as brewery premises.

9 Other enactments

Nothing in these Regulations shall derogate from the provisions of any
other enactment and in particular (without limiting the generality of the foregoing),
the Public Health Act 1965, and the Food Control Act 1981.
240 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

10 Appeals to Court

PART 4
APPEALS AND OFFENCES
(1) Any person who is operating a brewery and who is dissatisfied with the requirements of a notice served by an Inspector pursuant to regulation 8 may, within 21 days of the service of the notice, appeal to the Court against the requirements of that notice, specifying the grounds of the appeal.
(2) The Court may confirm vary or annul the requirements of the notice appealed against.

11 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person who fails to comply with any provision of these
Regulations commits an offence and on conviction shall be liable to a fine not
exceeding 5 penalty units, and in the case of a continuing offence, to a further fine
of 0.5 penalty units for every day on which the offence is continued.
(2) Where any body corporate is guilty of an offence under these
Regulations, and that offence is proved to have been committed with the consent
or connivance of, or to be attributable to any neglect on the part of, any director,
manager, secretary or other officer of the body corporate, or any person who was
purporting to act in any such capacity, that person, as well as the body corporate,
shall be guilty of that offence and shall be liable to be proceeded against accordingly.
––––––––––––––––––––

1 Floors

SCHEDULE (Regulation 3)

(a) Floors shall be constructed of impervious and easily cleaned material that is resistant to wear and corrosion, and shall be adequately graded and drained.

(b) The materials of which the floors are constructed shall in any event be suited to the work or process carried out on the premises.

2 Walls

(a) The internal surface of the walls shall be constructed of dust-proof

materials, and shall be smooth, even, and non-absorbent, and shall be

able to be readily cleaned without damage to the surface.

(b) The internal surface of the walls shall be either painted or treated with

such other finish as an Inspector may approve.

(c) All windows shall be fitted with insect screens, and suitable means of

destroying insects within the premises shall be employed.

3 Ceilings

Every ceiling or, where no ceiling is provided, the undersurface of the roof, and

every support shall be of such construction and finish as to –

(i) Provide a smooth, even surface that is dust-proof; and

(ii) Permit efficient and thorough cleaning.

4 Lighting

The illumination provided in the premises shall be of sufficient intensity to enable

effective inspection and cleaning of the premises, and to enable the purposes for which

the premises are used to be satisfactorily carried out.

Liquor 241

5 Ventilation

(a) The premises shall be provided with such ventilation as is necessary to

maintain comfortable conditions for persons in the premises.

(b) As far as practicable, the ventilation shall be adequate –

(i) To prevent the air on the premises from become excessively heated;

and

(ii) To prevent condensation and the formation of excess moisture on

the floors, walls and ceilings; and

(iii) For the removal of objectional odours, fumes, and impurities from

the premises.

(c) If the premises do not have adequate natural ventilation for the purposes

of sub-paragraph (a) and (b), they shall be provided with a mechanical

ventilation system that obtained air flow from a clean area.

(d) Where the premises are provided with a mechanical ventilation system,

it shall discharge air (including any vapours, gases, and other products

produced during any brewing process) in a manner that does not create a

nuisance.

6 Space

(a) The premises shall contain sufficient floor space –

(i) To enable every person working there to carry out his work efficiently;

and

(ii) To allow easy access for cleaning purposes.

(b) Every working space, aisle, passageway, or area on the premises, to which

it is intended that customers shall have access, shall be unobstructed and

shall be sufficiently spacious to allow movement by workers and invitees.

7 Toilet accommodation

(a) The premises shall be provided with sufficient toilet accommodation, in

accordance with the Public Health Act 1965 for the workers on the

premises.

(b) All toilet accommodation shall be convenient to the places where the

workers for whom it is provided are engaged in their work.

8 Wash-hand basins

The premises shall be provided with wash-hand basins for the use of the workers

engaged there.

9 Water supply

The premises shall be provided with an adequate supply of clear, wholesome

water.

10 Hot water supply

The premises shall be provided with a hot water system having a storage capacity

approved by an Inspector to supply, during the time in every day when the premises are

used, an adequate and continuous supply of piped hot water –

(a) At a temperature of not less than 63 degrees celsius at all sinks and other

equipment that are used for the washing of containers, utensils and

appliances; and

(b) At a temperature of not less than 83 degrees celsius for every other purpose

for which hot water is required under these regulations.

242 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

11 Plumbing

The premises shall be provided to the satisfaction of an Inspector with sinks,

sanitary fixtures and accessories, or other plant or appliances, that are of sufficient capacity

to enable all appliances, containers, utensils and equipment used in the premises to be

cleaned efficiently and rendered hygienic in accordance with the requirements of these

regulations.

12 Sewage disposal

The premises shall be provided with sufficient suitable drains to carry away the

whole of the sewage and liquid wastes from the premises to a sewer, sewage tank or

other outfall, in accordance with the Public Health Act 1965.

243

MISUSE OF DRUGS

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The Misuse of Drugs law is the subject of a current reform Bill. The Regulations are therefore not reproduced.

The Regulations can be found in Niue Legislation as at 1 August 1990 vol 4 p444.]

244 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

245

NIUE

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The Marine Pollution Act 1974 (NZ) as at 19 October 1974 is Niue law. The Oil in Navigable Waters Act 1965 (NZ) was made Niue law by the Niue (New Zealand) Laws Regulations 1972. The Marine Pollution Act 1974 (NZ) repealed the Oil in Navigable Waters Act

1965 (NZ) and thereby (except sections 37-39 and Part 5) became Niue law by substitution by virtue of section 676 of the Niue Act 1966. There are three Oil in Navigable Waters regulations subsisting under this Act. The Act and its regulations are not reproduced in this volume; they can be found in Niue Legislation as at 1 August 1990 vol 4.]

AUDIT REGULATIONS 1970

1

Title

11

Powers of Audit Office as to payment of

2

Interpretation

royalties

3

Inspection and audit

12

Cabinet or Audit Office may investigate

4

Inspectors

accounts in connection with Government

5

Audit Office may report to Minister

contracts

6

Controller and Auditor-General’s precept

13

Statutory and local authorities

7

Surcharges

14

Audit fees and costs

8

Recovery of surcharges

15

Report of Audit Office

9

Appeal as to surcharges

16

Offences and penalties

10

Passing of payments without receipts

1 Title

These are the Audit Regulations 1970.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“accounting officer” means an imprestee, receiver, or other person who is
required to render an account under any enactment or appointment;
and includes every person who, by any enactment or by virtue of any
appointment, is charged with the duty of collecting or receiving, or
who does actually collect or receive, any public money, or who is
charged with the duty of disbursing, or who does actually disburse,
any public money, or who is charged with the purchase, receipt, custody,
or disposal of or the accounting for any public stores;
“Act” means the Niue Act 1966;
“Audit Office” means the Auditor-General;
“Auditor-General” means the Auditor-General of New Zealand;
“imprestee” means any person in whose hands any public money is placed
for expenditure in the public service;
“local authority” means any Council, Board, Trustees, Commissioners, or
other persons, by whatever name designated, entrusted by or under
authority of any enactment with the administration of the affairs of
any municipality, district, or village and having power to levy rates or
taxes or to impose fines or penalties;
246

3

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

“public money” means money, or securities of any kind for the payment of money, received for or on account of, or payable to, or belonging to, or deposited with, the Crown or the Government or any Department or agency of the Government; and includes public securities;
“public securities” means securities representing the investment of any public money;
“public stores” or “stores” means chattels, machinery, livestock, or buildings in the possession or under the control of any Department or agency on account of the Government;
“statutory authority” means any Council, Board, Trustees, Commissioners, or any other persons, by whatever name designated, entrusted with the administration of any scheme, trust, fund or other undertaking of a public nature established by or under the authority of any enactment.

Inspection and audit

(1) The Audit Office shall inspect, examine, and audit the books and
accounts of every accounting officer and of every other person concerned in the accounting, collection, receipt, custody, or expenditure of public money or stores. (2) The Audit Office shall have free access at all convenient times to the accounts and records relating to any public money or stores and to the offices or premises in which any such accounts or records are located; and it shall be the duty of all persons whomsoever to afford all such information as the Audit Office at any time requires, and to answer all such questions as may be addressed to them or any of them by the Audit Office touching any public money or stores, or any account thereof, or any other matter which may enable the Audit Office to
fulfil the duties imposed on it by these regulations.
(3) The Audit Office may cause search to be made in and extracts taken
from any book, document, or record in any public office without paying any fee
therefor.
(4) The Audit Office shall make such examination, reviews and tests as it
considers necessary of the accounts and transactions relating to any public money
and stores to ascertain whether, in the opinion of the Audit Office –
(a) The accounts have been faithfully and properly kept;
(b) Internal controls and procedures applied are sufficient to ensure
that all money is accounted for and to secure an effective check on
the assessment, collection, and proper allocation of revenue;
(c) Internal controls and procedures applied are sufficient to secure an
effective control over expenditure, and to ensure that expenditure
has been properly authorised and charged against the proper
appropriation provided by the Assembly;
(d) Internal controls and procedures applied are adequate for proper
custody and control of stores and for the maintenance of essential
stores records.
(5) The provisions of this regulation shall, with the necessary modification,
apply to all accounts and transactions in respect of money or stores required to be
audited by the Audit Office under any enactment.

Niue 247

4 Inspectors

The Auditor-General may, by writing under his hand, appoint any officer
of the Audit Department or other fit person to inspect, examine, or audit any
books, accounts, or stores, which are required to be inspected, examined, or audited
by these Regulations or by any other enactment and to report thereon to him; and
for the purposes of any such inspection and report any such officer or other person
shall have power to inspect all books, accounts, vouchers, and other papers relating
thereto.

5 Audit Office may report to Minister

(1) The Audit Office may communicate with the Minister or any other
person whomsoever upon any account or transaction subject to audit by the Audit
Office under these regulations or any other enactment.
(2) The Audit Office may report to the Minister the name of any person
failing to comply with the requirements of these Regulations, or of any other
enactment relating to public money or public stores, and thereupon, and until the
failure is made good to the satisfaction of the Minister, all salaries and money that
may be or become due to that person may be withheld.

6 Auditor-General’s precept

(1) The Auditor-General may, by precept under his hand, require any such
person as he thinks fit to appear personally before him or any officer of the Audit
Department at a time and place to be named in the precept, and to produce any
accounts, vouchers, books, or papers in the possession or control of that person.
(2) The Auditor-General or officer of the Audit Department shall have full
power to examine any such person on oath touching the receipt, expenditure of or
otherwise dealing with any public money or stores, and touching all other matters
necessary for the due execution of the powers vested in the Audit Office by these
regulations.
(3) Every person who is compelled under this regulation to attend before
the Audit Office shall be entitled to be paid from the Niue Government Account
such expenses as the Audit Office certifies to be reasonable.

7 Surcharges

(1) If it appears to the Audit Office that in any account or transaction subject
to its audit there has been any deficiency or loss, or that any money has not been
fully and properly accounted for, by reason of the fact that –
(a) Any accounting officer or other person has wilfully or negligently
omitted to collect, receive, or account for any money; or
(b) Any money has been applied and charged to any service or purpose
for which it was not legally available and applicable; or
(c) Any payment has been made without proper authority or has not
been duly vouched; or
(d) There has been a deficiency or loss of money or stores, or
expenditure of money, or damage to stores, or expenditure for the
replacement or repair of stores, caused through the fraud, mistake,
default, negligence, or error of, or improper or unauthorised use
by, any person; or
(e) Any material error has been committed; or
(f) Any of the provisions of these Regulations, or of any other
enactment relating to public money or public stores, have not been
complied with –
248 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
the Auditor-General may call on the person who appears to him to be in default or responsible to show cause why he should not be surcharged with the amount of the deficiency or loss, notifying that person in writing of the proposed surcharge and of the time within which he is required to state why he should not be surcharged.
(2) In any case in which the amount of any deficiency or loss cannot be
accurately determined, the Auditor-General shall make an estimate of the
deficiency or loss, and that estimate shall for all purposes be deemed to be correct.
(3) On receipt of any explanation submitted by any person who has been
called on to show cause why he should not be surcharged, or in default of any
such explanation, the Auditor-General shall, if he considers the circumstances
warrant it, issue a surcharge for the amount concerned. The person surcharged
shall be notified by the Auditor-General of the time within which the surcharge
must be satisfied.
(4) Any surcharge unsatisfied within the time so allowed shall be reported
by the Auditor-General to the Minister, to be by him enforced against the person
surcharged.
(5) The Auditor-General may at any time revoke any surcharge made by
him under this regulation if he considers it to have been made in error.
(6) Nothing in this regulation shall prevent the recovery without surcharge,
from any person liable to be surcharged, of the amount of the deficiency or loss, or
of so much thereof as the Auditor-General thinks fit, as a debt due to the Crown.
(7) If any person having possession or control of any public money or stores
applies the same, or causes or permits the same or any part thereof to be applied,
to other than public services, or is a defaulter in respect of any such money or
stores, the Audit Office shall forthwith take all such steps as it thinks fit to prosecute
the offender according to law, but nothing herein shall prevent the prosecution of
that person by any person other than the Audit Office.

8 Recovery of surcharges

(1) (a) The Minister, on receiving the Audit Office report of an unsatisfied
surcharge, may direct Cabinet to take such steps to recover the
amount as the case may require. No amount payable to or claimed
by that person shall be paid until the surcharge has been satisfied,
and the amount of the surcharge shall be recoverable from that
person as a debt due to the Crown;
(b) Payment of not more than one-fifth of the net salary for any pay
period of any officer surcharged shall be withheld under this
regulation.
(2) All money recovered under this regulation shall be paid into the account
which suffered the deficiency or loss in respect of which the surcharge was issued.

9 Appeal as to surcharges

Any person who has been surcharged and who is dissatisfied with that
surcharge may within one month after the date of the service on him of notice of
the surcharge appeal to the Minister, who, after making such investigation as he
deems equitable, may make such order as he thinks fit either confirming the
surcharge or directing the relief of the appellant therefrom either wholly or in
part, whereupon the amount of the surcharge which has not been remitted shall
become due and payable and subject to regulation 8.

Niue 249

10 Passing of payments without receipts

Cabinet on satisfactory evidence being provided that the receipts or other
requisite papers have been lost or destroyed or that it is not possible to obtain or
replace them, may order that any payment of public money be allowed as paid
without production of receipts, and the Audit Office may after making such
inquiries as it considers desirable pass the payment accordingly.

11 Powers of Audit Office as to payment of royalties

The Audit Office may inspect and examine the books and accounts of any
person who is for the time being liable for the payment to the Crown of any royalties
under any lease or licence.

12 Cabinet or Audit Office may investigate accounts in connection with

Government contracts

(1) For the purposes of this regulation the term “Government contract”
means any contract for the supply of any goods or the execution of any works in
consideration of any payment out of public money, and includes any subcontract
made in relation to any such contract.
(2) This regulation shall apply with respect to any Government contract
whether or not the contract has been wholly or partly performed and executed.
(3) For the purpose of obtaining any information in relation to any
Government contract, Cabinet or the Auditor-General may –
(a) Inspect, examine, and audit any books, accounts, vouchers, records,
or documents;
(b) Require any person to produce any books, accounts, vouchers,
records, or documents in his possession or under his control, and
to allow copies of or extracts from any such books, accounts,
vouchers, records, or documents to be made;
(c) Require any person to furnish in a form to be approved by or
acceptable to the Auditor-General, any information or particulars
that may be required by him;
(d) Inspect, measure, and test any real or personal property;
(e) Enter any land, building or place.
(4) Cabinet or the Auditor-General may delegate to any person or class of
persons, or to the holder or holders of any office or class of offices, any of the
powers conferred by this regulation. Any such delegation may be at any time
revoked.
(5) Every person commits an offence against this regulation who –
(a) Resists, obstructs, deceives, or attempts to deceive any person who
is exercising or attempting to exercise any power or function under
this regulation;
(b) Makes any false or misleading statement or any material omission
in any information or particulars furnished under this regulation;
(c) Fails to comply in any respect with any requirement under this
regulation.
(6) Every person who aids, abets, counsels, or procures, or is in any way
knowingly concerned with, the commission of an offence against this regulation
shall be deemed to have committed an offence against this regulation.
(7) Any offence against this regulation committed by a servant or agent in
the course of his employment shall be deemed to have been also committed by his
employer or principal.
250 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(8) Every person who commits or attempts to commit an offence against this regulation is liable –
(a) In the case of an individual, to imprisonment for a term not exceeding 3 months or to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit and (if the offence is a continuing one) to a further fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day during which the offence has continued, or to both such imprisonment and such fines;
(b) In the case of a company or other corporation, to a fine not exceeding
10 penalty units and (if the offence is a continuing one) to a further
fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for every day during which the
offence has continued.

13 Statutory and local authorities

The functions and powers of the Audit Office under these Regulations shall
extend to the inspection, examination, and audit of the accounts of every statutory
authority and every local authority in Niue created, incorporated, or established
by any enactment.

14 Audit fees and costs

(1) The cost of the audit of its accounts, public money, and public stores
shall be borne by the Government of Niue.
(2) Where the Audit Office is appointed auditor of any body or of any
accounts or transactions, whether under these regulations or any other enactment
or otherwise howsoever, fees shall be payable to the Audit Office in respect of the
audit at such a rate as the Minister of Finance fixes.
(3) In addition to the aforesaid fees and costs, the Audit Office shall be
reimbursed for all travelling expenses and other disbursements in connection with
its duties as prescribed by these regulations.
(4) The amount payable to the Audit Office in respect of any such fees,
costs, expenses, or disbursements shall be a debt due to the Crown, and shall be
recoverable in any court.

15 Report of Audit Office

Cabinet shall on receipt of the report of the Audit Office submitted under
the Constitution, present the report and the statements of accounts or funds which
have been audited by the Audit Office together with reports thereon to the
Assembly forthwith if then meeting, and if not, then at the first sitting of the next
meeting.

16 Offences and penalties

(1) Every person who refuses or neglects to pay any public money into the
account into which that money is payable is liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty
units.
(2) Every person who refuses or neglects to make any return or furnish any account, vouchers, or other papers which he is required to make or furnish under these Regulations, not being an offence under regulation 12 is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units.
(3) Every person commits an offence and is liable to a fine not exceeding 2 penalty units, who –
(a) Fails to attend at the time and place required of him by the Auditor-
General or any other person under these Regulations for the purpose
of being examined; or

Niue 251

(b) Fails to produce any accounts, books, vouchers, or papers in his possession or under his control which he is required to produce; or
(c) Refuses to be sworn or to answer any lawful question asked him by the Cabinet or other person authorised to act in his behalf or by the Audit Office –
not being an offence under regulation 12.
(4) Every person who is guilty of any wilful act of commission or omission
contrary to any of these Regulations for which no penalty is expressly provided is
liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(5) All proceedings for an offence against these Regulations shall be
commenced upon the information of any person appointed by Cabinet in that
behalf, either generally or in any particular case.
252 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

BIRTHS AND DEATHS REGISTRATION REGULATIONS 1984

1984 – 1 July 1984

1

Title

PART 3

2

Interpretation

REGISTRATION OF DEATHS

19

Form of Register of Deaths

PART 1

20

Particulars of deaths

REGISTRATION GENERALLY

21

Persons responsible for reporting deaths

3

Appointment of Registrar

22

Entry in Register of Deaths

4

Place of registration of births and deaths

23

Informant may sign Register of Deaths

24

Certificate by medical practitioner

PART 2

25

Deaths not attended

REGISTRATION OF BIRTHS

26

Failure by medical practitioner to give

5

Form of Register of Births

certificate

6

Particulars required for registration

27

Notice by Minister of religion

7

Persons responsible for reporting births

8

Notification form

PART 4

9

Entry in the Register of Births

GENERAL PROVISIONS

10

Certificate of registration

28

Registers open to public

11

Births not previously registered

29

Issue of certified copy for official use

12

Births occurring outside Niue

30

Evidence of entries

13

Change of name

31

Failure to supply required particulars

14

Informant may sign Register of Births

32

Fees

15

Entry of father ’s name

33

Custody of Registers

16

Notice to attend on Registrar

34

Correction of errors

17

Legitimated children

35

Regulations to apply to stillborn child

18

Late registration

36

Failure of Registrar to register information

37

Discretion of Registrar

SCHEDULES

1 Title

These are the Births and Deaths Registration Regulations 1984.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“informant” means any person required by these Regulations to furnish to
the Registrar particulars of a birth or death, as the case may be;
“register” means the Register of Births or the Register of Deaths, as the
case may be;
“Registrar” means the Registrar appointed under these Regulations and
includes a Deputy Registrar so appointed.
PART 1
REGISTRATION GENERALLY

3 Appointment of Registrar

There shall be appointed under Part VI of the Constitution such fit and
proper persons as may be required to be Registrar and Deputy Registrar.

4 Place of registration of births and deaths

All births and deaths occurring in Niue shall be registered by the Registrar
whose office is in Alofi.

Niue 253

PART 2
REGISTRATION OF BIRTHS

5 Form of Register of Births

The Register of Births shall be in form 1 in Schedule 1.

6 Particulars required for registration

(1) For the purpose of these Regulations, the following particulars of a
birth occurring in Niue shall be furnished to the Registrar –
(a) The date and place of birth;
(b) The christian or first name and sex of the child;
(c) The names of the father and mother respectively; when and where
married, ages, place of birth, place of residence and occupations;
(d) The description of the father and mother (race to be stated in fuln( �br/>[For example, Europeans, Niuean, half-European, half-Niuean];
(e) The name, address, occupation and relationship of the informant
to the child;
(f) The date of registration.
(2) The particulars of births specified in paragraph (1) shall be furnished
to the Registrar within 14 days after the birth of the child.

7 Persons responsible for reporting births

(1) The following persons shall be responsible for furnishing to the
Registrar particulars of births specified in regulation 6, namely –
(a) In the case of a birth occurring in the public hospital, the midwife,
nursing sister or nurse-in-charge at the time of birth;
(b) In the case of a birth occurring outside of hospital, the father or
mother of the child;
(c) Every occupier of the house or building in which the child was
born;
(d) Any person present at the birth of the child.
(2) If any of the persons specified in paragraph (1) duly furnishes the
required information, the others of those persons shall thereupon be freed from
the obligation of doing so.

8 Notification form

The notification form shall be in form 2 in Schedule 1.

9 Entry in Register of Births

(1) Upon receipt of the particulars of birth of any child born in Niue the
Registrar shall enter those particulars in the Register of Births.
(2) The Registrar may, notwithstanding that the full particulars required
by these Regulations have not been furnished, upon being satisfied with the
particulars furnished to him, register the birth of any child in the Register of Births.

10 Certificate of registration

The certificate of registration shall be in form 3 in Schedule 1.

11 Births not previously registered

Notwithstanding anything in these Regulations, the Registrar may register
the birth of any person born in Niue, whether before or after the commencing of
these Regulations, whose birth has not been previously registered.
254 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

12 Births occurring outside Niue

(1) Where a child born out of Niue arrives and before attaining the age of
24 months, and the parents or other persons having lawful charge of the child are
ordinarily resident in or about to take up their abode in Niue, a Registrar, on
application being made at any time within six months from the date of the child’s
arrival by one of the parents, or by a person having lawful charge, shall register
the birth of the child in the manner provided by these Regulations for the
registration of births taken place in Niue.
(2) Documentary evidence as to the date of birth of the child must be
submitted together with the application for the registration of such a birth.
(3) The Registrar shall not refuse the application of any person for
registration of the birth of the child born out of Niue on the ground of the non-
production of documentary evidence alone.

13 Change of name

(1) Any person whose birth is registered in Niue, and who has attained
the age of 21 years or is married or has at any time been married, may change his
or her name, whether as to his/her surname or as to any first name or christian
name.
(2) (a) The parents of any child who has not attained the age of 21 years and has never been married may change the name of the child, whether as to his/her surname or as to any first or christian name.
(b) Where the child has attained the age of 18 years his/her consent shall be required to the change of name.
(c) For the purposes of this paragraph the term “parents” –
(i) Where one of the parents has deserted the child or is dead or
unknown or missing or of unsound mind, means the other
parent;
(ii) Where the child has been adopted, according to the law in force
for the time being, means the adoptive parents or one of them;
(iii) Where the child has a legal guardian, means or includes that
guardian.
(3) (a) For the purpose of this Regulation, any change of name shall be
effected by Deed Poll in form 4.
(b) Any application at any time for the change of name shall be
restricted in all respects to not more than 2 applications except in
special circumstances and subject to the discretion of the Registrar
whose decision shall be final.
(4) Any change of name shall be registered at the Registrar ’s Office and
the original registration amended accordingly subject always to the payment of
the prescribed fee set out in Schedule 2 except where fees are being waived by the
Registrar in case of hardship or other valid reasons.
(5) Every certificate of the date of birth issue under this clause shall show
the name as changed and no other name and reference to the original name or
names for identification purposes.

14 Informant may sign Register of Births

Upon completing all the entries in the Register of Births, the Registrar shall
request the informant, if then present, to sign the entries but this condition is
obligatory rather than compulsory.

Niue 255

15 Entry of father’s name

Unless the informant states that the child is born in lawful wedlock or is
the posthumous child of lawfully married persons or unless the father together
with the mother attends personally at the Registrar ’s Office and make admission
that he is the father of the child and the mother agrees to the father ’s name being
entered in the Register of Births, or unless an affiliation order has been made under
Part 23 of the Niue Act 1966 in respect of the child, the Registrar shall not enter in
the Register of Births the name of any person as the father of the child.

16 Notice to attend on Registrar

Notwithstanding that the birth of any child has not been registered within
the period specified in regulation 5(2), the Registrar may after one month and not
later than 6 months after the birth of the child, by notice in writing (form 5) requires
the parent or parents or some person present at the birth of the child to attend
personally at his office within the time specified in the notice and give information
of the particulars required to be registered, and the Registrar shall thereupon
register the birth according to the information given.

17 Legitimated children

(1) (a) Upon the intermarriage of parents of an illegitimate child born in
Niue and upon application being made to the Registrar in whose
office the birth of the child is registered, the Registrar may register
the particulars of the father.
(b) Satisfactory evidence by statutory declaration or other such
evidence he may deem necessary of the paternity of that child shall
have been first given to the Registrar.
(2) Notwithstanding anything in paragraph (1) every case where it is not
practical for the natural parents to attend personally at the office of the Registrar
in whose office the birth was registered the application be made in writing with
support documentary evidence to the Registrar who may authorise the registration
of the particulars relating to the father.

18 Late registration

Notwithstanding the time restriction imposed by regulation 12 the Registrar
may authorise the registration of any birth which occurred out of Niue provided
that satisfactory evidence by statutory declaration or other evidence may be
deemed necessary as to the birth of the child irrespective as to whether or not the
birth of the child has been registered at the country where it originally occurred or
took place.
PART 3
REGISTRATION OF DEATHS

19 Form of Register of Deaths

The Register of Deaths shall be in form 6.

20 Particulars of deaths

(1) For the purpose of these Regulations, the following particulars of deaths
occurring in Niue shall be furnished to the Registrar –
(a) The date and place of death;
(b) The name and residence of the deceased;
(c) The sex of the deceased;
(d) The age of the deceased;
256 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(e) If married, the name of the deceased’s husband or wife; (f) The number and sex of children living (if any);
(g) The cause of death certified by a medical officer who attended the deceased during last illness;
(h) The duration of illness of the deceased (if known);
(i) The name of medical practitioner giving the certificate and brief
description of qualifications;
(j) The date when medical practitioner last saw the deceased;
(k) The names and descriptions of the father and mother of the deceased
(race to be stated in detail). For example, European, Niuean, half
European, and half Niuean and their place of residence;
(l) The name, description, place or residence, occupation and degree
of relationship of informant (if any) to the deceased;
(m) The date of registration.
(2) The particulars of deaths specified in paragraph (1) shall be furnished
to the Registrar within 24 hours after death occurred.

21 Persons responsible for reporting deaths

(1) The following persons or officer shall be responsible for furnishing the
particulars of deaths specified in regulation 20, namely –
(a) The medical practitioner by issuing a death certificate duly executed
under his hand;
(b) Every occupier of the house or building in which the death took
place;
(c) Any person present at the death.
(2) If any of the persons or medical officer specified herein duly furnishes
the required information, the others of those persons or officers shall thereupon
be freed from the obligation of doing so.

22 Entry in Register of Deaths

(1) Upon the receipt of the particulars of death of any person dying in
Niue, the Registrar shall enter those particulars in the Register of Deaths.
(2) Notwithstanding that the full particulars required by these Regulations
have not been furnished, the Registrar, upon being satisfied with the particulars
furnished to him, may register the death of any person in the Register of Deaths.

23 Informant may sign Register of Deaths

Upon completing the entries in the Register of Deaths, the Registrar shall
request the informant, if then present, to sign the entries, but the informant shall
not be obliged to sign the entries.

24 Certificate by medical practitioner

(1) On the death of any person who has been attended during his/her last
illness by a medical practitioner, that medical practitioner shall sign and deliver
or cause to be delivered to the Registrar a certificate in form 7 in Schedule 1 stating
to the best of his knowledge and belief the causes of death (both primary and
secondary) and the duration of the last illness of the deceased.
(2) The particulars set forth in the said certificate shall be entered, together
with the name of the certifying medical practitioner in the Register of Deaths.

Niue 257

25 Deaths not attended

(1) On the death of any person in Niue where there is for the time being a
Director of Health and that person has not been attended by a medical practitioner
as aforesaid, the Director of Health or his deputy, as the case may be, or other
medical practitioner authorised by him in that behalf, shall sign and deliver, or
cause to be delivered, to the Registrar a certificate in form 8 in Schedule 1, stating
to the best of his knowledge and belief the cause of death (both primary and
secondary) of the deceased.
(2) (a) For the purpose of enabling him to issue such a certificate, the
Director of Health, and in his absence the Deputy Director of Health,
shall have the right to make such examination or who without
reasonable cause obstructs or interferes with the Director of Health
or his deputy, in conducting such an examination, is liable to a fine
not exceeding 1 penalty unit.
(b) If any relative of the deceased objects to such an examination being
made, the Director of Health or the deputy acting on his behalf,
may appeal to Cabinet whose decision shall be final.
(3) (a) On the receipt by the Registrar of a medical certificate under the
provision of this regulation, the Registrar shall issue to such person
as he deems entitled thereto an authority for the burial of the
deceased.
(b) Every such authority under his hand shall be in form 9 in Schedule
1.
(4) Where in any case to which paragraph (3) applies any person, without
an authority in form 9 being first obtained, bury or causes to be buried any person
who has died in Niue, he is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

26 Failure by medical practitioner to give certificate

Every medical practitioner required under regulations 24 and 25 to issue a
certificate in form 7 or form 8 in Schedule 1 concerning any death refuses or neglects
to give that certificate, and any person to whom any such certificate is given who
fails to deliver the certificate to the Registrar is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5
penalty units.

27 Notice by Minister of religion

Every Minister of religion or other person who performs any religious or
funeral service for or at the burial of any dead body, or the person who conducts
the burial of any dead body shall give or forward within 7 days written notice of
the burial in form 10 in Schedule 1 to the Registrar.
PART 4
GENERAL PROVISIONS

28 Registers open to public

(1) The Registers to be kept under these Regulations shall at all reasonable
times be open to the public for search on payment of the appropriate fee prescribed
in Schedule 2.
(2) The Registrar shall, on the application of any person and on payment
of the appropriate fee prescribed in Schedule 2, issue certificates of any entry made
in the said Registers.
(3) Notwithstanding this regulation, the Registrar may dispense with the
payment of any fee payable under these Regulations in cases of genuine hardship.
258 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

29 Issue of certified copies for official use

(1) Notwithstanding regulation 32, where a certified copy of any entry in
a Register kept under these Regulations or a certificate as to any entry is required
for the purposes of any Government Department, the Registrar shall issue the
certified copy or special certificate in the prescribed form, free of charge.
(2) Every certified copy or certificate issued under paragraph (1) shall
indicate the purpose for which it was issued and shall not be available for any
other purpose, and shall be retained by the Department for whose purposes it
was required.

30 Evidence of entries

A certified copy of or a certificate relating to any entry in a Register, made
or given and purporting to be issued and signed by the Registrar and sealed and
stamped with his seal, shall be received in any court as prima facie evidence of the
birth or death to which it relates.

31 Failure to supply required particulars

(1) Every person required by these Regulations to furnish particulars in
respect of any matter who, without sufficient cause, fails to furnish those particulars
is liable for a first offence to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and for a second
or any subsequent offence to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and any person
who wilfully furnishes false particulars is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty
unit.
(2) Where any person who is convicted under these Regulations for failure to furnish the particulars required for the registration of any birth or death, the court shall direct the Registrar forthwith to register the birth or death, and if the birth or death has not been previously registered the Registrar shall register the birth or death accordingly.

32 Fees

For the purposes of these Regulations, the fees specified in Schedule 2 shall
be payable to the Registrar as the case may require.

33 Custody of Registers

(1) The Registers shall be safely kept by the Registrar in whose custody
they are placed, and shall be deemed to be the property of the Crown.
(2) Upon the death, dismissal, transfer or resignation of the Registrar, the
custody of those Registers shall pass to his successor in office.

34 Correction of errors

(1) Any clerical error or any error of fact or substance or any omission of
any material fact in any Register may be corrected by the Registrar as the case
may require.
(2) (a) Instead of making any correction as aforesaid, the Registrar may, if
he thinks fit, direct a new entry to be made in the Register.
(b) Any such entry shall contain a reference to the original entry, and
the original entry shall contain a reference to the new entry together
with the date of the correction.
(c) Any such new entry shall be signed by a person who is required
under these Regulations to give the particulars of birth or death, as
the case may be, or by such other persons as may be authorised by
the Registrar.

Niue 259

(3) For the purpose of this regulation, the Registrar may require to be produced a statutory declaration and such other evidence as to the facts as he considers necessary.
(4) Except as otherwise provided in these Regulations, no alteration in any
Register shall be made.

35 Regulations to apply to stillborn child

(1) (a) The provisions of these Regulations relating to the registration of
births shall apply in the case of a stillborn child, but a Registrar
may dispense with the registration of the death of any such child.
(b) A stillborn child shall be a child that has issued from its mother
after the expiration of the 28 weeks of pregnancy and was not alive
at the time of such issue.
(2) Particulars required for registration of a stillborn child shall be entered
on a separate Register kept specially for that purpose.

36 Failure of Registrar to register information

Where –
(a) The Registrar refuses or without reasonable cause omits to register
any birth or any death of which he had due notice and information;
or
(b) Any person having the custody of any Register or certified copy
thereof, or any part thereof, negligently loses or injures the same,
or negligently allows the same to be injured while in his keeping –
he is liable to a fine not exceeding 1 penalty unit.

37 Discretion of Registrar

Where for any sufficient cause shown to the satisfaction of the Registrar
any act, matter, or thing required by these Regulations cannot be done within the
time limited by or in strict compliance with the conditions imposed by these
Regulations, it shall be sufficient if that act, matter, or thing is done within a
reasonable time thereafter, or if the conditions imposed are complied with so far
as is reasonably possible.
––––––––––––––––––––
260 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Reg 5 Form 1 No.

NIUE REGISTRATION OF BIRTH

Child

Particulars

1 Date of Birth:

2 Place of Birth:

3 Christian and Surname:

4 Sex:

Parents

5 When Married:

6 Where Married:

Father

7 Name and Surname:

8 Age and Race:

9 Place of Birth and Residence:

10 Occupation:

Mother

11 Name and Surname:

12 Age and Race:

13 Place of Birth and Residence:

14 Occupation

Informant

15 Signature:

16 Residence:

17 Occupation:

18 Relationship to Child:

19 Date of Registration:

20 Signature of Registrar:

I certify that the above particulars are a true record of the birth of recorded this day of 20

Caution – Any person who (1) falsifies any of the particulars on this certificate; or (2) uses it as true knowing it to be false, is liable to prosecution under the Births and Deaths Registration Regulations 1984.

––––––––––––––––

Niue 261

Form 2

Issue No. 001

BIRTHS REGISTRATION REGULATIONS 1984 (Reg 8)

NOTIFICATION FORM

(To be delivered or posted to the Registrar of Births within 14 days after the birth)

The Registration of Births
Alofi, Niue
A TAKE NOTICE that a female/male child was born at Lord Liverpool Hospital on / /20
Full name of mother: Village of residence:
Signature of Nurse/Midwife/Nursing Sister in attendance and date:

/ /20

IF CHILD STILLBORN complete the following and delete where not applicable.
(a) Stillborn – born to of
on / /20
(b) Report pending/Report not required

C FOR OFFICE USE ONLY
Signature of Medical Practitioner
(a) Registered by: (b) Notice to parents sent on / /20
(c) All actions completed on / /20
(d) Registration No.:

Signature of officer responsible for the final actions
Form 3 Issue No. CERTIFICATE OF REGISTRATION
(Reg 10)
THIS IS TO CERTIFY that the birth of a male/female child born on

/ /20

has been registered in this office.

Name of Child:

Registration No:

Name of mother:

Name of father:

Village of residence:

Date of registration: / /20

Deputy Registrar Note: This is not a birth certificate but it can be used locally for school enrolment purposes, etc.
262 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
BIRTHS AND DEATHS REGULATIONS 1984 (Reg 13)
Form 4
CHANGE OF NAME BY DEED POLL
(Full Name) I, (Full Address) of (Occupation) am
desirous of abandoning and renouncing the use of the name of
(Old Name) I hereby absolutely abandon and renounce the use of the name

and HEREBY DECLARE that at all times here after
(New Name) I shall use and subscribe the name (Old Name) in lieu of the name in all deeds
and documents and in all acts and proceedings and in all
transactions and matters and things and upon all occasions, AND
I HEREBY AUTHORISE all persons at all times hereafter to
describe and address me by the name of
(New Name) IN WITNESS WHEREOF I have here subscribed the name of
(Old Name) and also my assumed name of
(New Name) this day of 20
SIGNED by the said
hereafter to be known as

in the presence of

Signature: Old Name



New Name

Witness:

Address:

Occupation:

Niue 263

Form 5
BIRTHS REGISTRATION REGULATIONS 1984
(Reg 16)
OFFICE OF REGISTRAR OF BIRTHS
ALOFI
NIUE
To:


The birth of your child which occurred on the
has not yet been registered at my office.
You are therefore reminded that registration should be effected on or before the

day of 20


Registrar
NOTE: If the birth is not registered within 14 days the persons responsible for registration render themselves LIABLE TO PROSECUTION.
264 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
REGISTER OF DEATHS Form 6 (Reg 19)
Registered at Alofi, in the Island of Niue
Entry NO:

DECEASED

1. Date of death:

2. Place of death:

3. Name:

4. Residence:

5. Sex:

6. Age:

7. Name of husband or wife (if any):

8. Number and sex of children living (if any):

9. Causes of death:

10. Duration of last illness:

11. Name of medical practitioner giving certificate and his qualifications (if any):

12. Date when medical practitioner last saw deceased:

PARENTS OF DECEASED

Mother

13. Name:

14. Residence:

15. Description:

Father

16. Name:

17. Residence:

18. Description:

INFORMANT

19. Signature:

20. Residence and occupation:

21. Degree of relationship (if any) to deceased:

REGISTRAR

22. Date of registration:

23. Signature of Registrar:

I solemnly declare that to the best of my knowledge and belief the foregoing particulars are true in every respect.
––––––––––––––––––––––––––– Signature of Registrar

Niue 265

Form 7
BIRTHS AND DEATHS REGISTRATION REGULATIONS 1984
(Reg 20)
MEDICAL CERTIFICATE OF CAUSES OF DEATH
A Particulars as to deceased:
Name of deceased:
Sex: Aged as stated to me:
Date of death: , day of 20
Place of death;
Last seen by me: , day of 20
B Causes of death (State clearly in full and not in abbreviated form)
1 Disease, injury or complication (a)

directly leading to death:
due to, or as a consequence of: (b)
due to, or as a consequence of: (c)

2. Other significant factors:
3. Appropriate between onset and death:
C Additional data (delete box not applicable)
1. Did you see the body after death: Yes No
2. Post mortem (a) not intended to be held Yes No
(b) held and results available Yes No
(c) being or to be held Yes No
I, certify that I was in medical attendance during the abovenamed deceased’s last illness and the particulars quoted above are true to the best of my knowledge and belief.
(1)
(2) (3)
Signature of Medical Officer Qualifications Date
Note: Form 8 to be completed if Medical Practitioner did not attend the deceased during his/her last illness AND NOT THIS FORM
266 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
Form 8
CERTIFICATE OF DEATH BY MEDICAL OFFICER OF PERSON NOT
ATTENDED BY A MEDICAL OFFICER
(Reg 20)
TO THE REGISTRAR OF BIRTHS AND DEATHS, NIUE
I, the undersigned, hereby certify that I have examined the body of who is reported to have died at on the day of 20
To the best of my knowledge and belief the causes of death were:
Primary
Secondary
Witness by hand this day of 20 at
–––––––––––––––––––––––– Medical Officer
Form 9
AUTHORITY TO BURY
(Reg. 25(3))
To of
I , the Registrar of Births and Deaths, Niue
hereby authorise the burial of the body of who died at
on the day of 20
Witness by hand this day of 20
at
––––––––––––––––––––––––
Registrar
Please advise the deceased family that this death must be registered within one week

Niue 267

Form 10
CERTIFICATE AS TO BURIAL
(Reg 27)
I, , of , hereby certify that the body of
was duly buried on the day of _____________20 _______in my presence

Minister and Denomination
––––––––––––––––––––

Reg 30

SCHEDULE 2

FEES TO BE TAKEN BY REGISTRAR

1. Subject to (2) for every certified copy or certificate relating to an entry in any register

2. For every “urgent” issue of a certified copy or certificate of birth

3. For registration of a name change including the issue of a birth certificate

$10.00

$15.00

$15.00

FEES TO BE TAKEN BY NIUE CONSULATE GENERAL OFFICE IN NEW ZEALAND

1. For every certified copy or certificate relating to an entry in any register

2. For re-typing worn out copies of any certified copy or certificate relating

to an entry in any register

$25.00

$15.00

268 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

CO-OPERATIVE SOCIETIES REGULATIONS 1953

1 Title

PART 1
PRELIMINARY
These are the Co-operative Societies Regulations 1953.

2

3 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“bonus” means a share of the profits of a registered society divided among
its members in proportion to the volume of business done with the
society by them from which the profits of the society were derived;
“by-laws” means the registered by-laws made by a society in the exercise
of any power conferred by these Regulations, and includes a registered
amendment to the by-laws;
“committee” means the governing body of a registered society to whom
the management of its affairs is entrusted;
“dividend” means a share of the profits of a registered society divided
among its members in proportion to the share capital held by them;
“member” includes a person or registered society joining in the application
for the registration of a society; and also includes a person or registered
society admitted to membership after registration in accordance with
the by-laws;
“officer” includes a chairman, secretary, treasurer, member of committee,
or other person empowered under these Regulations or under by-laws
to give directions in regard to the business of a registered society;
“registered society” means a co-operative society registered under these
Regulations;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of Co-operative Societies appointed under
regulation 4; and includes any person when exercising such powers of
the Registrar as may have been conferred upon him under that
regulation;
“Rules” mean rules made under regulation 52.
PART 2
REGISTRATION

4 Appointment of Registrar and Assistant Registrar

(1) Under Part VI of the Constitution –
(a) A Registrar of Co-operative Societies;
(b) Such other suitable persons to assist the Registrar as may be deemed
necessary.
(2) Cabinet may by notice publicly displayed, confer on any persons
appointed under subparagraph (1)(c) all or any of the powers of the Registrar
under these Regulations.

5 Societies which may be registered

Subject to these Regulations, a society which has as its object the promotion
of the economic interests of its members in accordance with co-operative principles,
or a society established with the object of facilitating the operations of such a
society, may be registered under these Regulations with limited liability.

Niue 269

6 Conditions of registration

(1) No society, other than a society of which at least one member is a
registered society, shall be registered under these Regulations, unless it consists of
at least 10 persons, each of whom is qualified for membership under regulation
22.
(2) No society of which any member is a registered society shall be registered under these Regulations unless it consists of at least 2 members, each of whom in the case of members other than registered societies is qualified for membership under regulation 22.
(3) The word “co-operative” or its vernacular equivalent shall form part of the name of every society registered under these Regulations.
(4) The word “limited” or its vernacular equivalent shall be the last word
in the name of every society registered under these Regulations.
(5) When for the purposes of this regulation any question arises as to age,
residence, or occupation of land constituting the qualification of any person, that
question shall be decided by the Registrar, whose decision shall be final.

7 Application for registration

(1) For the purposes of registration an application shall be made to the
Registrar.
(2) The application shall be signed –
(a) In the case of a society of which no member is a registered society,
by at least 10 persons qualified under the requirements of regulation
6 (1); and
(b) In the case of a society of which at least one member is a registered
society, by a duly authorised person on behalf of every such
registered society and, where all the members of the society are not
registered societies, by each of the other members.
(3) The application shall be accompanied by copies of the proposed by­
laws of the society, and the persons by whom or on whose behalf the application
is made shall furnish such information in regard to the society as the Registrar
may require.

8 Registration

(1) (a) If the Registrar is satisfied that a society has complied with these
Regulations and that its proposed by-laws are not contrary to these
Regulations, he may, if he thinks fit, register the society and its by­
laws.
(b) An appeal against the refusal of the Registrar to register any society
shall lie to Cabinet within one month from the date of that refusal,
and the decision of Cabinet on any such appeal shall be final.
(2) On registration the society shall pay such fee as may be prescribed by
the rules.
(3) A certificate of registration signed by the Registrar shall be conclusive
evidence that the society therein mentioned is duly registered, unless it is proved
that the registration of the society has been cancelled.

9 Societies to be bodies corporate

Registration of a society shall render it a body corporate by the name under
which it is registered, with perpetual succession and a common seal and with
power to acquire, hold, and dispose of property, to enter into contracts, to institute
and defend suits and other legal proceedings, and to do all things necessary for
the purpose of its constitution.
270 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 3
DUTIES AND PRIVILEGES OF SOCIETIES

10 By-laws of a registered society

(1) Every registered society shall have by-laws which, subject to these
Regulations and the rules, shall provide for the following matters –
(a) The name of the society;
(b) The objects for which the society is established;
(c) The modes in which persons become members of the society;
(d) The modes in which persons cease to become members of the
society;
(e) The mode in which the by-laws may be altered, added to, or
rescinded;
(f) The mode of summoning and holding general meetings of the
society and of voting there;
(g) The appointment of officers of the society;
(h) The control and use of the common seal of the society;
(i) Such matters as by these Regulations or the rules are required to be
prescribed by the by-laws;
(j) Such other matters as the Registrar may require to be provided for
in any particular instance.
(2) The by-laws of any registered society may contain any other provisions
which are not inconsistent with these Regulations or the rules or with law.

11 Amendment of the by-laws of a registered society

(1) Any registered society may, subject to these Regulations, amend its by­
laws, including the by-law which declares the name of the society.
(2) No amendment of the by-laws of a registered society shall be valid
until that amendment has been registered, for which purpose copies of the
amendment shall be forwarded to the Registrar.
(3) (a) If the Registrar is satisfied that any amendment of the by-laws is
not contrary to these Regulations, he may, if he thinks fit, register
the amendment.
(b) An appeal against the refusal of the Registrar to register any
amendment of any by-law shall lie to Cabinet within one month
from the date of that refusal, and the decision of the Cabinet on any
such appeal shall be final.
(4) An amendment which changes the name of a society shall not affect
any right or obligation of the society or of any of its members or past members,
and any legal proceedings pending may be continued by or against the society
under its new name.
(5) Where the Registrar registers an amendment of the by-laws of a
registered society he shall issue to the society a copy of the amendment certified
by him, which shall be conclusive evidence of the fact that the amendment has
been duly registered.
(5) In this regulation “amendment” includes the making of a new by-law
and the variation or rescission of a by-law.

12 Address of society

Every registered society shall have an address within Niue registered under
the rules to which all notices and communications may be sent, and shall send to
the Registrar notice of every change of that address.

Niue 271

13 Copy of regulations, rules and by-laws and list of members to be open for inspection

(1) Every registered society shall keep a copy of these Regulations and the rules and its by-laws and a list of its members open to inspection, free of charge, at all reasonable times at the registered address of the society.
(2) For the purposes of paragraph (1) the copy of the rules and the by-laws
of any society shall be deemed to include all amendments thereto, and the society
shall cause to be endorsed on the copy of the rules or by-laws so kept a
memorandum of every such amendment.

14 Disposal of produce to or through a registered society

(1) A registered society which has as one of its objects the disposal of any
article produced or obtained by the work or industry of any of its members
(whether the article is the produce of agriculture, animal husbandry, forestry,
fisheries, handicrafts, or otherwise) may provide in its by-laws, or may otherwise
contract with its members –
(a) That every such member who produces any such article shall
dispose of the whole or any specified amount, proportion, or
description thereof to or through the society; and
(b) That any member who is proved or adjudged, in such manner as
may be prescribed by the rules, to be guilty of a breach of the by­
laws or contract shall pay to the society as liquidated damages a
sum ascertained or assessed in such manner as may be prescribed
by the aforesaid rules, and that sum shall be a debt due to the society
by the member.
(2) No contract entered into this regulation shall be contested in any court
on the ground only that it constitutes a contract in restraint of trade.

15 Creation of charges in favour of registered societies

Subject to any prior claim of the Crown on the property of a debtor, and to
the claim of the holder of any lien on any property, and to the claim of a landlord
in respect of rent or any money recoverable as rent, and, in the case of immovable
property, to any prior registered charge thereon and subject also to Niue
Amendment Act 1968 (No. 2) –
(a) Any debt or outstanding demand payable to a registered society
by any member or past member shall be a first charge on all crops
or other agricultural produce, felled timber, or other forest produce,
marine produce, fish (fresh water and salt water), livestock, fodder,
agricultural, industrial and fishing implements, plant, machinery,
boats, tackle and nets, raw materials, stock in trade, and generally
all produce of labour and things used in connection with production
and raised, purchased, or produced in whole or in part from any
loan whether in money or in goods given him by the society:
Provided that nothing in this paragraph shall affect the claim of
any bona fide purchaser or transferee without notice;
(b) Any outstanding demands or dues payable to a registered society
whose primary object is the provision of housing for its members
by any member or past member in respect of rent, shares, loans, or
purchase money or any other rights of amounts payable to the
society shall be a first charge upon his interest in the immovable
property of the society.
272 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

16 Charge and set off in respect of shares of interest of members

A registered society shall have a charge upon the shares or interests in the
capital and on the deposits of a member or past member or deceased member,
and upon any dividend, bonus, or profit payable to a member or past member or
to the estate of a deceased member, in respect of any debt due to the society from
that member or past member or estate, and may set off any sum credited or payable
to a member or past member or estate of a deceased member in or towards payment
of any such debt.

17 Shares or interest not liable to attachment

Subject to regulation 16, the share or interest of a member in the capital of
a registered society shall not be liable to attachment or sale under any decree or
order of any Court in respect of any debt or liability incurred by the member, and
neither his assignee in insolvency or a receiver duly appointed shall be entitled to
or have any claim on that share or interest.

18 Transfer of interest on death of member

(1) (a) On the death of a member, a registered society may transfer the
share or interest of the deceased member to the person nominated
in accordance with the rules made in that behalf, or, if there is no
person so nominated, to such person as may appear to the
committee to be the heir or legal representative of the deceased
member, or may pay to that nominee, heir, or legal representative,
as the case may be, a sum representing the value of the member ’s
share or interest, as ascertained in accordance with the rules or,
where there are no such rules or in so far as the rules do not provide,
by the by-laws.
(b) The society may transfer the share or interest of the deceased
member to that nominee, heir, or legal representative, as the case
may be, being qualified in accordance with the rules for membership
of the society, or, where there are no such rules or in so far as the
rules do not provide, by the by-laws of the society, or on his
application within 6 months of the death of the deceased member
to any person specified in the application who is so qualified.
(2) A registered society shall pay to that nominee, heir, or legal
representative, as the case may be, all other moneys due to the deceased member
of the society.
(3) All transfers and payments made by a registered society in accordance
with the provisions of this regulation shall be valid and effectual against any
demand made upon the society by any other person.

19 Deposits by or on behalf of minors

(1) A registered society may receive deposits from or on behalf of minors
and it shall be lawful for a registered society to pay to any such minors the interest
which may become due on those deposits.
(2) Any deposits made by a minor may, together with the interest accrued
thereon, be paid to that minor; and any deposit made on behalf of a minor may,
together with the interest accrued thereon, be paid to the guardian of that minor
for the use of the minor.
(3) The receipt of any minor or guardian for money paid to him under this
regulation shall be a sufficient discharge of the liability of the society in respect of
that money.

Niue 273

20 Register of members

Any register or list of members kept by any registered society shall be prima
facie evidence of any of the following particulars entered therein –
(a) The date at which the name of any person was entered in the register
or list as a member;
(b) The date at which any such person ceased to be a member.

21 Proof of entries in books of society

(1) A copy of any entry in a book of a registered society regularly kept in
the course of business shall, if certified in such manner as may be prescribed by
the rules, be received in any legal proceeding in any court (civil or criminal) as
prima facie evidence of the existence of that entry, and shall be admitted as evidence
of the matters, transactions, and accounts therein recorded in every case where,
and to the same extent as, the original entry itself is admissible.
(2) No officer of any such society shall, in any legal proceedings to which
the society is not a party, be compelled to produce any of the society’s books the
contents of which can be proved under paragraph (1), or to appear as a witness to
prove any matters, transactions, or accounts therein recorded, unless the court for
special reasons so directs.
PART 4
RIGHTS AND LIABILITIES OF MEMBERS

22 Qualifications for membership

In order to be qualified for membership of a society a person, other than a
registered society, must –
(a) Have attained the age of 18 years; and
(b) Be resident within or a titleholder by Niue custom within the
society’s areas of operations as described by the by-laws.

23 Members not to exercise rights till due payment made

No member of a registered society shall exercise the rights of a member
unless he has made such payment to the society in respect of membership or
acquired such interest in the society, as may be prescribed by the by-laws of the
society.

24 Restriction of membership in society

Except with the sanction of the Registrar, no person shall be a member of
more than one registered society whose primary object is to grant loans to its
members.

25 Votes of members

(1) No member of any registered society shall have more than one vote in
the conduct of the affairs of the society.
(2) In the case of an equality of votes the Chairman shall have a casting
vote.
(3) In the case of societies the membership of which includes one or more
registered societies, each last-mentioned society may have such voting powers as are provided in the by-laws.

26 Representation by proxy

A registered society that is a member of any other registered society may
appoint any one of its members as its proxy for the purpose of voting in the conduct
of the affairs of that other registered society.
274 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

27 Contracts with society of members who are minors

The minority of any person duly admitted as a member of any registered
society shall not debar that person from executing any instrument or giving any
acquittance necessary to be executed or given under these Regulations or any
rules made thereunder and shall not be a ground for invalidating or avoiding any
contract entered into by any such person with the society; and any such contract
entered into by any such person with the society, whether as principal or as surety,
shall be enforceable at law or against that person notwithstanding his minority or
non-age.

28 No individual to hold more than one-fifth of share capital of any society

No member, other than another registered society, shall hold more than
one-fifth of the share capital of any registered society.

29 Restrictions on transfer of share or interest

The transfer or charge of the share or interest of a member or past member
or deceased member in the capital of a registered society shall be subject to such
conditions as to maximum holding as may be prescribed by these Regulations or
by the rules.

30 Limitation of liability of members

(1) In the event of a registered society being wound up, every present and
past member of the society shall be liable to contribute to the assets of the society
to an amount sufficient for payment of its debts and liabilities, and the costs,
charges, and expenses of the winding up, and for the adjustment of the rights of
those members among themselves, subject to the following qualifications –
(a) A past member shall not be liable to contribute if he has ceased to
be a member for 2 years or upwards before the commencement of
the winding up;
(b) A past member shall not be liable to contribute in respect of any
debt or liability of the society contracted after he ceased to be a
member;
(c) A past member shall not be liable to contribute unless it appears to
the Registrar that the existing members are unable to satisfy the
contributions required to be made by them under these Regulations;
(d) In the case of a society limited by shares no contribution shall be
required from any member exceeding the amount, if any, unpaid
on the shares in respect of which he is liable as a present or past
member;
(e) In the case of a society limited by guarantee no contribution shall,
subject to paragraph (2), be required from any present or past
member exceeding the amount undertaken to be contributed by
him to the assets of the society in the event if its being wound up.
(2) In the winding up of a society limited by guarantee which has a share
capital, every member of the society shall be liable, in addition to the amount
undertaken to be contributed by him to the assets of the society in the event of its
being wound up, to contribute to the extent of any sums unpaid on the shares in
respect of which he is liable as a past or present member.
(3) The personal representatives of the estate of a person who was a member
of a registered society at the commencement of the winding up of the society or
had ceased to be a member of the society within the period of 2 years preceding
the commencement of the winding up shall be liable in a due course of
administration to contribute to the assets of the society in discharge of his liability.

Niue 275

PART 5
PROPERTY AND FUNDS OF REGISTERED SOCIETIES

31 Loans made by a registered society

(1) (a) A registered society shall not, except as provided by regulation 34
make any loan to any person other than a member.
(b) With the consent of the Registrar a registered society may make
loans to another registered society.
(2) Except with the permission of the Registrar a registered society shall
not lend money on the security of any movable property other than produce or
goods in which the society is authorised to deal.
(3) Cabinet may, by general or special order publicly notified, prohibit or
restrict the lending of money by any registered society on mortgage of any
description of immovable property.

32 Deposits and loans received by a registered society

A registered society may receive deposits and loans from persons who are
not members only to such extend and under such conditions as may be prescribed
by the rules or, where there are no such rules or in so far as the rules do not provide,
by the by-laws of the society.

33 Restrictions on other transactions with non-members

Save as provided in regulations 31 and 32, the transactions of a registered
society with persons other than members shall be subject to such prohibitions and
restrictions as may be prescribed by the rules.

34 Investment of funds

A registered society may invest or deposits its funds –
(a) In the Post Office Savings Bank or with any bank approved for this
purpose by the Registrar; or
(b) In any securities issued or guaranteed by the Government or any
country that is a member of the Commonwealth; or
(c) With any other registered society approved for this purpose by the
Registrar; or
(d) In any other manner approved by the Registrar.

35 Disposal of profits

(1) (a) Where a registered society is entitled by its constitution to make a
profit it shall carry a reserve fund at least one-fourth of the net
profits, if any, made during every year as ascertained by the audit
prescribed by regulation 36.
(b) The remainder of those profits and any profits of past years available
for distribution may be divided among the members by way of
dividend or bonus, or allocated to any fund constituted by the
society, to such extent as may be prescribed by the rules or, where
there are no such rules or in so far as the rules do not provide, by
the by-laws of the society.
(2) Any registered society may, with the sanction of the Registrar after one-
fourth of the net profits in any year have been carried to a reserve fund, contribute
an amount not exceeding 10 per cent of the remaining net profits to any charitable
purpose or to a fund established or maintained for the common good.
(3) No society shall pay a dividend or bonus or distribute any part of its
accumulated funds before the balance sheet has been certified by the Registrar
and the amount of the dividend, bonus, or distribution, as the case may be, has
been approved by the Registrar.
276 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

36 Audit

PART 6
AUDIT, INSPECTION AND INQUIRY
(1) The Registrar shall audit, or cause to be audited by some person authorised by him by general or special order in writing, the accounts of every registered society once at least in every year.
(2) The audit under paragraph (1) shall include an examination of overdue debts, if any, and a valuation of the assets and liabilities of the registered society. (3) The Registrar and every other person appointed to audit the accounts
of a society shall have power when necessary –
(a) To summon at the time of his audit any officer, agent, servant, or
member of the society who he has reason to believe can give material
information in regard to any transaction of the society or the
management of its affairs; or
(b) To require the production of any book or document relating to the
affairs of, or any cash or securities belonging to, the society by the
officer, agent, servant, or member in possession of that book,
document, cash or securities.
(4) Every officer, agent, servant, or member of the society shall furnish
such information in regard to the transactions of the society and the management
of its affairs and shall produce such articles as aforesaid as may be required under
paragraph (3) by the Registrar or other person appointed to audit the accounts of
the society.

37 Power of Registrar to inspect society’s books

The Registrar, or any person authorised by general or special order in
writing by the Registrar shall at all times have access to all the books, accounts,
papers, and securities of a registered society, and shall be entitled to inspect the
cash in hand, and every officer of the society shall furnish such information in
regard to the transaction and working of the society as the person making the
inspection may require.

38 Inquiry and inspection

(1) The Registrar may of his own motion, and shall on the application of a
majority of the committee or of not less than one-third of the members of a
registered society, hold an inquiry, or direct some person authorised by him by
order in writing in this behalf to hold an inquiry, into the constitution, working,
and financial condition of a registered society; and all officers and members of the
society shall furnish such information in regard to the affairs of the society and
produce the cash in hand and such books, accounts, papers, and securities of the
society as the Registrar or the person authorised by him may require.
(2) The Registrar shall, on the application of a creditor of the registered
society, inspect, or direct some person authorised by him in writing in his behalf
to inspect the books of the society, if the applicant –
(a) Proves that an ascertained sum of money is then due to him and
that he has demanded payment thereof and has not received
satisfaction within a reasonable time; and
(b) Deposits with the Registrar such sum as security for the costs of
the proposed inspection as the Registrar may require.
(3) The Registrar shall communicate the results of any such inspection to
the creditor and to the society into whose affairs inquiry has been made.

Niue 277

39 Costs of inquiry and inspection

(1) Where an inquiry is held under regulation 38 (1) or an inspection is
made under regulation 38 (2) the Registrar may by certificate under his hand
apportion the costs, or such part of the costs as he thinks fit, between the registered
society, the members demanding the inquiry, the officers or former officers of the
society, and the creditor, as the case may be, on whose application the inquiry or
inspection was made.
(2) The Registrar of Co-operative Societies may, without any previous
process file in the Court the certificate referred to in paragraph (1) and the Registrar
of the Court shall enter final judgment in that Court for the sums mentioned in
the certificate to be paid by the persons specified therein, and thereupon execution
may be forthwith issued and all other remedies had thereon in the same manner
as any other decree of the Court.
PART 7
WINDING UP

40 Winding up after inquiry or by consent

(1) If the Registrar, after holding an inquiry or making an inspection under
regulation 38 or on receipt of an application made by three-fourths of the members
of a registered society, is of opinion that the society ought to be wound up, he may
make an order for the winding up of the society.
(2) Any member of a registered society may within 2 months from the
date of an order under paragraph (1) appeal from the order to Cabinet and the
decision of Cabinet on any such appeal shall be final.
(3) (a) Where no appeal is presented within 2 months from the making of
an order for the winding up of a society, the order shall take effect
on the expiry of that period.
(b) Where an appeal is presented within 2 months, the order shall not
take effect until it is confirmed.
(4) Where the Registrar makes an order under paragraph (1) for the
winding up of a society, he may make such further order as he thinks fit for the
custody of the books and documents and the protection of the assets of the society
until the winding up order takes effect.
(5) No registered society shall be wound up save by an order of the
Registrar.

41 Winding up due to lack of membership or failure to carry on operations

(1) The Registrar may make an order for the winding up of any registered
society if at any time it is proved to his satisfaction that –
(a) The number of members has been reduced to less than 10 or, in the
case of a society of which at least one member is a registered society,
to less than 2; or
(b) The society is no longer carrying on its operations; or
(c) The society has been registered by reason of a mistake of fact or
law.
(2) Every such order shall take effect from the date thereof.
(3) At any time thereafter the Registrar, on being satisfied that the winding
up order was made in error and ought to be revoked, may revoke the order by
notice publicly notified, and shall thereupon make an entry of the revocation in
the Register.
278 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

42 Appointment of liquidator

Where the Registrar makes a winding up order under regulation 40 or
regulation 41, he may appoint one or more persons to be liquidator or liquidators
of the society, subject to his direction and control.

43 Liquidator’s powers

(1) A liquidator appointed under regulation 42 shall, subject to the guidance
and control of the Registrar and to any limitations imposed by the Registrar by
order under regulation 44, have power to –
(a) Determine the contributions to be made to its assets by members
and past members or by the estates of deceased members of the
society;
(b) Appoint by notice a day before which creditors whose claims are
not already recorded in the books of the society shall state their
claims for admission or be excluded from any distribution made
before they have proved them;
(c) Decide any question of priority which arises between creditors;
(d) Refer disputes to arbitration or institution and defend suits and
other legal proceedings on behalf of the society by his name or office;
(e) Decide by what persons and in what proportions the costs of
liquidation are to be borne;
(f) Give such directions in regard to the collection and distribution of
assets as may be necessary in the course of winding up the society;
(g) Compromise any claim by or against the society provided the
sanction of the Registrar has first been obtained;
(h) Call such general meetings of members as may be necessary for the
proper conduct of the liquidation;
(i) Take possession of the books, documents, and assets of the society;
(j) Sell the property of the society;
(k) Carry on the business of the society as far as may be necessary for
winding it up beneficially:
Provided that nothing in this subparagraph shall entitle the
liquidator of a credit society to issue any loan;
(l) Arrange for the distribution of the assets of the society in a
convenient manner when a scheme of distribution has been
approved by the Registrar.
(2) Subject to such rules as may be made in this behalf, any liquidator
appointed under these regulations shall, in so far as such powers are necessary
for carrying out the purposes of this regulation, have power to summon or enforce
the attendance of parties and witnesses and to compel the production of documents
by the same means and as far as may be in the same manner as is provided in the
case of the Court.

44 Power of registrar to control liquidation

A liquidator shall exercise his powers subject to the control and revision of
the Registrar, who may –
(a) Rescind or vary any order made by a liquidator and make whatever
new order is required;
(b) Remove a liquidator from office;
(c) Call for all books, documents and assets of the society;
(d) By order in writing limit the powers of a liquidator under regulation
43;
(e) Require accounts to be rendered to him by the liquidator;

Niue 279

(f) Procure the auditing of the liquidator ’s accounts and authorise the distribution of the assets of the society;
(g) Make an order for the remuneration of the liquidator;
(h) Refer any subject of dispute between a liquidator and any third
party to arbitration if that party consents in writing to be bound by
the decision of the arbitrator.

45 Enforcement of order

(1) Subject to regulation 51 the decision of an arbitrator on any matter
referred to him under regulation 44 shall be binding on all parties, and shall be
enforceable in the manner provided in paragraph (2).
(2) An order made by a liquidator or by the Registrar under regulation 43
or 44 may be enforced by the Court in like manner as a decree of that Court.

46 Appeal against order of liquidator or Registrar

An appeal against any decision made by a liquidator under regulation 43
or against any decision made by the Registrar under regulation 44 (a), may, with
the written consent of the Cabinet be made to the Court in the manner and time
prescribed in that written consent.

47 Completion of liquidation and dissolution of society

(1) In the liquidation of a society whose registration has been cancelled
the funds, including the reserve fund, shall be applied first to the costs of
liquidation, then to the discharge of the liabilities of the society (which shall abate
rateably if the funds are insufficient), then to the payment of the share capital, and
then, provided the by-laws of the society permit, to the payment of a dividend at
a rate not exceeding 10 per cent per annum for any period for which no disposal
of profits was made.
(2) When the liquidation of a society has been completed, notice of the
completion of the liquidation shall be publicly notified by the Registrar in such
manner as he thinks proper; and as from the date of that notification the society
shall be deemed to be dissolved and shall cease to be a body corporate.
(3) Any surplus remaining after the completion of the liquidation shall be
available for use by the Registrar for any co-operative purpose at his discretion.
PART 8
SURCHARGE OF OFFICERS

48 Power of Registrar to surcharge officers of a registered society

(1) Where in the course of the winding up of a registered society it appears
that any person who has taken part in the organisation or management of the
society or any past or present officer of the society has misapplied or retained or
become liable or accountable for any money or property of the society or has been
guilty of misfeasance or breach of trust in relation to the society, the Registar may,
on the application of the liquidator or of any creditor or contributory, examine the
conduct of the first-mentioned person and, notwithstanding that the at is one for
which the offender may be criminally responsible and whether or not he has been
charged with an offence in respect of the matter, make an order requiring him to
repay or restore the money or property or any part thereof with interest at such
rate as the Registrar thinks just or to contribute such sum to the assets of the
society by way of compensation in regard to the misapplication, retainer,
dishonesty, or breach of trust as the Registrar thinks just.
(2) Subject to regulation 49 , every person against whom any order is made
under paragraph (1) shall forthwith comply with that order.
280 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

49 Appeal to Cabinet

Any person aggrieved by any order of the Registrar made under regulation
48 may appeal to Cabinet within 21 days from the date of the order, and the decision
of Cabinet shall be final and conclusive.

50 Settlement of disputes

PART 9
DISPUTES
(1) If any dispute touching the business of a registered society arises –
(a) Among members, past members, and persons claiming through
members, past members, and deceased members; or
(b) Between a member, past member, or person claiming through a
member, past member, or deceased member, and the society, its
committee, or any officer of the society; or
(c) Between the society or its committee and any officer of the society;
or
(d) Between the society and any other registered society,
the dispute shall be referred to the Registrar for decision.
(2) A claim by a registered society for any debt or demand due to it from
a member or past member or the nominee, heir, or legal representative of a deceased
member shall be deemed to be a dispute touching the business of the society within
the meaning of this regulation.
(3) The Registrar, may, on receipt of a reference under paragraph (1) –
(a) Decide the dispute himself; or
(b) Refer it for disposal to an arbitrator or arbitrators.

51 Appeal

(1) Any party aggrieved by an award made under regulations 45 or 50 by
the Registrar or by an arbitrator or arbitrators appointed appointed by him may
appeal therefrom in the manner and time prescribed by the rules to the Court.
(2) On an appeal under paragraph (1) the Court may dismiss the appeal or
vary the award of the Registrar or arbitrator or arbitrators to make such other
order as may appear just and proper, and shall make such order as to the costs of
the arbitration and the appeal as it thinks fit, and the decision of the Court shall be
final.

52 Rules

PART 10
RULES
(1) Subject to these regulations, Cabinet may make all such rules as it considers necessary for the purpose of carrying out or giving effect to the principles and provisions of these regulations.
(2) In particular and without prejudice to the generality of the power conferred by paragraph (1), the rules may –
(a) Prescribe the forms to be used, the fees to be paid, the conditions to be complied with in applying for the registration of a society, and the procedure in the matter of those applications;
(b) Prescribe the extent to which a registered society may limit the number of its members;
(c) Provide for the appointment, suspension, and removal of the
members of the committee, and for the procedure at meetings of
the committee, and for the powers to be exercised and the duties to
be performed by the committee;

Niue 281

(d) Regulate the manner in which funds may be raised by means of shares or debentures or otherwise;
(e) Prescribe the conditions to be observed by a registered society applying for financial assistance from the Government;
(f) Prescribe the payments to be made, the conditions to be complied with, and the forms of the bonds, instruments, or other documents to be executed, by members applying for loans or cash credits, the period for which loans may be made or credits granted, and the maximum amount which may be lent and the maximum credit which may be allowed to individual members with or without the consent of the Registrar;
(g) Provide for the mode in which the value of a deceased member ’s
interest shall be ascertained and for the nomination of a person to
whom any such interest may be paid or transferred;
(h) Provide for the mode in which the value of the interest of a member
who has become of unsound mind and incapable of managing
himself or his affairs shall be ascertained and for the nomination of
any person to whom any such interest may be paid or transferred;
(i) Provide for the formation and the maintenance of reserve funds,
and the objects to which those funds may be applied, and for the
investment of any funds under the control of any registered society;
(j) Prescribe the maximum rate of dividend which may be paid by
societies;
(k) Prescribe the accounts and books to be kept by a registered society,
and for the periodical publication of a balance sheet showing the
assets and liabilities of a registered society;
(l) Provide for the audit of the accounts of registered societies and for
the charges, if any, to be made for that audit, and provide for the
levy of contributions from all or any registered societies to a fund
to be used for the audit and supervision of existing societies and
co-operative propaganda and prescribe for the administration of
any such fund;
(m) Prescribe the returns to be submitted by registered societies to the
Registrar and the person by whom and the form in which the returns
are to be made;
(n) Provide for the persons by whom, and the form in which, copies of
entries in books of registered societies may be certified;
(o) Provide for the formation and maintenance of a register of members
and, where the liability of members is limited by shares, of a register
of shares;
(p) Prescribe the mode of appointing an arbitrator or arbitrators and
the procedure to be followed in proceedings before the Registrar or
the arbitrator or arbitrators;
(q) Prescribe the procedure to be followed by a liquidator appointed
under regulation 42;
(r) Prescribe the forms to be used, the fees to be paid, the procedure to
be observed, and all other matters connected with or incidental to
the presentation, hearing, and disposal of appeals under these
regulations.
(3) Cabinet shall publicly notify in such manner as it thinks fit rules made
by Cabinet under this regulation.
282 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
PART 11
MISCELLANEOUS

53 Recovery of sums due to Crown

(1) All sums due to the Crown from a registered society or from an officer
or member or past member of a registered society as such may be recovered in the
manner provided for the recovery of debts due to the Crown under the law for
the time being in force.
(2) Sums due from a registered society to the Crown and recoverable under
paragraph (1) may be recovered first from the property of the society, and secondly
on the winding up of the society from the members subject to the limit of their
liability.

54 Power to exempt from stamp duty and registration fees

The Cabinet may, by notice in writing in the case of any registered society
or class of societies remit –
(a) The stamp duty with which, under any law for the time being in
force, instruments executed by or on behalf of a registered society,
or by an officer or member, and relating to the business of the society
or any class of those instruments are respectively chargeable; or
(b) Any fee payable for registration for the time being in force.

55 Prohibition of the use of the word “Co-operative”

(1) No person other than a registered society shall trade or carry on business
under any name or title of which the word “Co-operative” or its vernacular
equivalent is part without the consent of Cabinet.
(2) Any person who commits a breach of this regulation is guilty of an
offence and is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and in the case of a
continuing offence to a further fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for each day
during which the offence continues.
penalty unit, who –
(a) Being a registered society or an officer or member of a society,
wilfully neglects or refuses to do any act or to furnish any
information required by or for the purposes of these Regulations
by the Registrar or by any person authorised by the Registrar in
writing in that behalf; or
(b) Being a registered society or an officer or member of a society, when
required to make a return or supply any information for the
purposes of these regulations wilfully makes a false return or
supplies false information; or
(c) Wilfully or without reasonable cause disobeys any summons,
requisition, or lawful written order issued under these Regulations.

58 Penalty for soliciting violation of contract

Any person who, having knowledge or notice of the existence of a contract
described in regulation 14, solicits or persuades any person to sell or deliver any article in violation of that contract is guilty of an offence and is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and shall in addition be ordered to pay to the society concerned such damage as to the court may seem fit.

Niue 283

DENTAL REGULATIONS 1970

1970 – 25 May 1970

1 Title

These are the Dental Regulations 1970.

2 Meaning of “practice of dentistry”

In these regulations, “the practice of dentistry” includes –
(a) The performance of any operation, and the treatment of any
diseases, deficiencies, or lesions, on or of the human teeth or jaws,
and the correction of malpositions thereof and the performance of
radiographic work in connection with the human teeth or jaws;
(b) The giving of any anaesthetic in connection with any operation on
the human teeth or jaws;
(c) The mechanical construction or the renewal of artificial dentures
or restorative dental appliances;
(d) The performance of any operation on, or the giving of any treatment,
advice, or attendance to, any person, as preparatory to or for the
purpose of or for or in connection with the fitting, insertion, fixing,
constructing, repairing, or renewing of artificial dentures or
restorative dental appliances;
(e) The performance of any such operation and the giving of any such
treatment, advice, or attendance as is usually performed or given
by registered dentist.

3 Practice of dentistry

(1) No person shall practise dentistry in Niue or hold himself out, whether
directly or by implication, as practising or being entitled to practise dentistry in
Niue, unless he is registered in New Zealand as a dentist.
(2) Notwithstanding anything in paragraph (1) –
(a) A graduate in dentistry of the Fiji School of Medicine, or any person
who has such knowledge of and training in dentistry as are in the
opinion of Cabinet equal to that of such a graduate, may practise
dentistry in Niue as an employee of the Niue Public Service subject
to the general control of the Chief Medical Officer;
(b) A medical officer and any other person qualified to practise
medicine or surgery in Niue may perform any dental operation, or
do any other act that is within the meaning of “the practice of
dentistry”, in the ordinary course of practice as such or in any case
where the services of a person qualified to practise dentistry in Niue
are not obtainable;
(c) Any person may extract a tooth where the case is urgent and no
person qualified to practise dentistry in Niue and no person referred
to in subparagraph (b) and (c) is available, provided the operation
is performed without the application of any general or local
anaesthetic;
(d) Any person acting under the direction of a person entitled to practise
dentistry in Niue may construct or renew artificial dentures or
restorative dental appliances.
(3) Every person commits an offence who does any act in contravention of
this regulation, and is liable to a fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units and in the
case of a continuing offence, to a further fine not exceeding 0.5 penalty units for
every day on which the offence has occurred.
284 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

GAMING (FEES) REGULATIONS 2005

2005/4 – 24 June 2003

1 Title

These are the Gaming (Fees) Regulations 2005.

2 Permitted gambling activities

The gambling activities set out in the Schedule are permitted in Niue, subject
to the restrictions and payment of fees set out in the Schedule.

3 Gambling permit

No person except –
(a) A society incorporated under the Incorporated Societies Act 1908,
and whose objects are principally sport, recreational or purposes
of benefit to the community;
(b) An unincorporated body of persons associating for sporting,
recreational or purpose of benefit to the community, and which –
(i) is substantially permanent in nature; and
(ii) has a standing committee; and
(iii) operates a bank account
shall permit any person to be engaged in on any premises for the time being
occupied by it or until its control, any gambling activity except pursuant to, and
in accordance with the terms and conditions of a permit issued under these
Regulations.

4 Application for permit

(1) Every application for a permit under these Regulations shall be made
in writing to the Chief of Police, and shall be in such form and contain such
information as the Chief of Police may require;
(2) On receipt of an application for a gambling permit, the Chief of Police
may –
(a) Approve the application either wholly or in part, and subject to such terms and conditions as the Chief of Police may think fit to impose; or
(b) Decline the application.

5 Offences

Any person who contravenes these Regulations or fails to comply with a

Niue 285

HIGH COURT RULES 1916

1 These are the High Court Rules 1916.

2 Every civil proceeding shall be instituted either by way of action, or by way of petition, or by way of motion, in accordance with the following Rules.

3 The following proceedings shall be instituted by way of action: (a) Every proceeding for the recovery of debt or damages; (b) Every proceeding for the recovery of land or chattels;

(c) Every proceeding for injunction, prohibition, or mandamus; (d) [Repealed by SR 1962/72]
(e) Every proceeding which by the law for the time being in force in New Zealand must, if instituted in the High Court, be commenced by writ of summons or originating summons.

4 Every proceeding against the Crown shall be commenced by way of petition.

5 All other civil proceedings not being proceedings for a decree of divorce or nullity of marriage may be commenced by way of motion.

Actions

6 Every action shall be commenced by filing with a Registrar of the Court a

statement of claim intituled “In the High Court of Niue” setting forth the names
and descriptions of the plaintiff and defendant, the nature of the cause of action,
and the relief claimed. Forms similar to those in Schedule 1 may be used.

7 On the filing of the statement of claim the Registrar shall thereupon issue, under the seal of the Court, a summons to the defendant in form 1 of Schedule 2, requiring the defendant to appear at the trial of the action at the time and place mentioned in the summons. A copy of the statement of claim shall be annexed to the summons.

8

9 The time and place of the trial of the action shall be determined by the

Registrar as he thinks fit, and shall be stated in the summons accordingly.

10 As against any defendant who consents to trial without summons, an action duly commenced by the filing of a statement of claim may be tried and determined without the issue or service of any summons.

11 No pleadings other than the statement of claim shall be required in any action.

12 The Court may require a plaintiff at or before the trial of the action to file a fuller and more explicit statement of his claim, and may stay further proceedings in the action until this has been done.

13 A plaintiff may at any time before or during the trial amend his statement of claim with the leave of the Court.

286 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

14 (1) The summons to a defendant may, as the Registrar thinks fit, be served either by an officer of the Court or by the plaintiff or his agent.

(2) Proof of service may be made either by affidavit or by a witness at the
trial.

15 (1) The summons shall be served on the defendant in person.

(2) Where there are more defendants than one, a separate summons shall,
except in the case of a firm of partners, be issued and served on each defendant.

16 The summons may be served upon a corporation by leaving the same at any place of business of the corporation.

17 When partners are sued as partners they may be sued either in the firm name or in the names of the partners, and in either case the summons may be served by delivering it to any one of the partners or by leaving it at any place of business of the firm.

18 When a defendant is not in Niue but has an attorney or agent authorised to defend actions on his behalf, the summons may by lave of the Court be served upon such attorney or agent.

19 The summons may be served anywhere in Niue but not elsewhere except in accordance with the provisions of these Rules for service outside Niue.

20 If it appears to the Court that reasonable efforts have been made to effect service of the summons, and either that the summons has come to the knowledge of the defendant or that prompt personal service thereof cannot be effected, the Court may order that the plaintiff be at liberty to proceed as if personal service had been effected, subject to such conditions as the Court thinks fit to impose.

21 A summons may be served out of Niue by leave of the Court –

(a) Where the cause of action or some material part thereof has arisen
in Niue;
(b) Where the subject-matter of the action is property situated in Niue;
(c) Where it is sought to compel or restrain the performance of any act
in Niue.

22 Every application for an order for leave to serve a summons out of Niue shall be supported by evidence by affidavit or otherwise, showing in what place or country the defendant is or probably may be found, and whether the defendant is a New Zealand subject or not, and the grounds on which the application is made.

23 If in any action a summons has become inoperative by reason of not being served in due time, or if for any other reason it is considered expedient to issue a further summons to the same defendant, a further summons may be issued accordingly in the same manner as if no previous summons had been issued.

24 No action shall be deemed improperly constituted because of the joinder of plaintiffs or defendants or of different causes of action; but the Court may, in any case in which such joinder is considered embarrassing or otherwise expedient order any party or cause of action to be struck out.

Niue 287

25 Where there are numerous persons having the same interest in an action one or more of them may sue or be sued, or may be authorised by the Court to defend in such action, on behalf of or for the benefit of all persons so interested.

26 The Court may at any stage of the proceedings, either upon or without the application of either party, and on such terms as appear to the Court to be just, order that the name of any party, whether a plaintiff or a defendant, improperly joined be struck out, and that the name of any person who ought to have been joined, or whose presence before the Court may be necessary to enable the Court effectually and completely to adjudicate upon and settle all the questions involved in the action, be added, whether as plaintiff or defendant.

27 No person shall be added as a plaintiff without his own consent.

28 Infants and lunatics may sue and be sued by a guardian ad litem admitted for that purpose by the Court.
29 A guardian ad litem may be removed by the Court upon sufficient cause being shown.
30 In the case of the death, retirement, or removal of an ad litem a fresh guardian shall be appointed by the Court.
31 A guardian ad litem shall not be permitted to retire without the leave of the
Court.
32 The guardian ad litem shall be liable for the costs of the action.
33 In an action against an infant or a lunatic the statement of claim may be filed before the appointment of a guardian ad litem, but no further steps in the action shall be taken until such appointment has been made.
or by the party at whose instance the witness is summoned or his agent.

36 Without the leave of the Court no such summons shall be issued requiring any witness to attend at any place outside the island in which he is resident or present at the date of the issue of the summons.

37 Witnesses in civil proceedings, whether summoned or not, shall be entitled to such payment in respect of their expenses and loss of time as the Court awards.

38 If the claim in any action is for a sum of money the defendant may, before trial of the action, pay into Court a sum of money by way of satisfaction, and give notice of such payment to the plaintiff.

39 Any money paid into Court as aforesaid may be paid out to the plaintiff or his duly authorised agent, but the receipt thereof shall not affect the right of the plaintiff to proceed with the action for the recovery of any further sum claimed and not so paid into Court.

288 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

40 The fact that money has been so paid into Court shall be taken into consideration in the award of costs as between the plaintiff and defendant.

41 The plaintiff may at any time before trial discontinue his action, either wholly or as to any cause of action, by filing in Court a memorandum of discontinuance.

42 A copy of such memorandum shall be served upon the defendant.

43 On any such discontinuance the Court may award to the defendant such costs of the action as it thinks fit.

44 The discontinuance of an action shall not be a defence to any subsequent action on the cause of action discontinued, provided that the costs of the previous action so awarded have been paid.

45 No judgment shall be given in any action by default, and every action shall be heard and determined in the ordinary course whether the defendant appears on the trial or not.

46 If on the trial of any action the plaintiff does not appear, the Court may either adjourn the trial, or give judgment for the defendant, or nonsuit the plaintiff.

47 The plaintiff in any action may at any time before judgment elect to be nonsuited, and the Court may nonsuit the plaintiff without his consent.

48 After a nonsuit the plaintiff shall not be debarred from commencing a further action on the same cause of action, all the costs of the first action having been first paid.

49 No action shall be tried by a jury.

50 The parties to any action may concur in stating the questions of law arising in the action in the form of a special case for the opinion of the Court.

51 Every such special case shall concisely state such facts and documents as may be necessary for the decision of the questions raised therein.

52 On the argument of the special case the Court shall be at liberty to draw from the facts and documents so stated any inference of fact which might have been drawn therefrom if proved at the trial.

53 On the argument of the questions of law raised in such special case the Court may give judgment in the action, or may order the issues of fact or any of them to be tried before giving judgment.

54 Every judgment debt in excess of $200 shall carry interest at the rate of 6 per cent per annum from the time of judgment being given until the same is satisfied, and such interest may be levied under any writ of execution upon such judgment.

Niue 289

the Court ex parte on the application of the judgment creditor, and shall specify the property to which it relates.

58 So long as any such order remains in force the amount of the judgment debt shall constitute an equitable charge upon the property specified in the order.

59 For the purpose of enforcing any such charge the Court may, and either on the making of the charging order or any time thereafter, on the ex parte application of the judgment creditor, make such order or orders as it thinks fit against all persons concerned –
(a) For the appointment of a receiver of the rents, profits, or revenues of any property so charged; or
(b) For the payment into Court in satisfaction of the judgment of any such rents, profits, or revenues, or of any moneys subject to the charge; or
(c) For the sale of any such property by an officer of the Court, disobedience to any order so made shall constitute a contempt of Court.

60 Any charging order, or any order so made in pursuance of a charging order, may be at any time cancelled or varied on the application either of the judgment debtor or the judgment creditor, or of any other person concerned.

61 An application for an order against a judgment debtor under section 94 of the Niue Act 1966 may be in form 5 in Schedule 2.

62 A judgment summons under section 95 of the Niue Act 1966 may be in form 6 in Schedule 2.

63 Every such judgment summons shall be served in the same manner as a summons to a defendant on the commencement of an action, and all the provisions of these Rules as to the place and time of the hearing of an action shall apply also to the hearing of the application in respect of which such judgment summons is issued.

Motions

64 Every civil proceeding not required to be commenced by way of action or

petition may be commenced by way of motion.

65 Every interlocutory motion may be made either verbally in open Court or by filing with a Registrar an application setting forth briefly the nature and grounds of the relief sought by the applicant.

66 Every originating motion shall be made by filing with a Registrar an application setting forth briefly the nature and grounds of the relief sought by the applicant.

290 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

67 Motions may be made in the forms set forth in Schedule 3 or in forms to the like effect.

68 (1) Except where otherwise provided, or where the Court is satisfied that the nature of the motion if such that it may properly be made and determined ex parte, every motion shall be heard and determined only after due notice has been given to such persons as the Court may consider entitled thereto.
(2) All persons to whom notice has been given by the direction of the Court, or who appear on the hearing of the motion, shall be deemed to be parties to the proceeding.

69 Every proceeding which may be commenced by originating motion may, if the applicant thinks fit, be commenced by way of action instead.

70 Applications under section 13 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968 for the assessment of compensation shall be made by motion of the Cabinet or by any person claiming such compensation or any share thereof, and notice of such application shall be given to such persons interested as the Court directs.

71 Applications under Part 23 of the Niue Act 1966 for an affiliation order or maintenance order may be made by motion, with notice thereof to the defendant, except in cases in which the Court is authorised to hear the application ex parte under section 563 of the Niue Act 1966.

Probate and Letters of Administration

72 Probate of any will may be granted by the Court in form 7 in Schedule 2.

73 Letters of administration of the estate of an intestate may be granted by the

Court in form 8 in Schedule 2.

74 Letters of administration with the will annexed may be granted by the Court in form 9 in Schedule 2.

a will annexed, may be granted to his attorney acting under a power of attorney.

77 (1) Every executor or administrator shall, within 12 months after the grant of probate or letters of administration, or within such further period as the Court on application may direct, lodge with the Registrar a full and distinct account in writing of his administration of the estate.

(2) The account shall be verified by affidavit.

78 If an executor or administrator makes default in filing such an account within the time aforesaid, or if any account so filed is insufficient, the Court may on the application of any person interested, or on the application of the Registrar, order the executor or administrator to file an account or a further account within such time as the Court in such order appoints, and disobedience to such order shall be a contempt of Court.

Niue 291

Proceedings Under the Customs Act 1966

79 (a) Every penalty imposed by the Customs Act 1966 and recoverable

in the High Court may be recovered by action in the name and on
behalf of the Government of Niue as a debt due to the Crown.
(b) The High Court may give leave to serve out of Niue the summons
in any action for the recovery of any such penalty or any duty under
the Customs Acts.
(c) The judgment in an action for the recovery of any such penalty
may be enforced by way of proceedings for contempt of the Court,
and the failure of the defendant to satisfy such judgment shall
constitute a contempt of Court accordingly.
(d) Any person imprisoned for such contempt shall be released from
custody on satisfaction of the judgment.
(e) Proceedings for contempt shall not preclude any other method of
execution which would otherwise be available.

80 Every prosecution in the High Court for an offence against the Customs Act 1966 shall be commenced by an information laid by an officer of Customs in accordance with the ordinary criminal procedure of the High Court.

81 Every person arrested in Niue for an offence against the Customs Act 1966 under section 267 of that Act shall be brought before a Judge or Commissioner of the High Court.

82 (a) Proceedings in the Court under the Customs Act 1966 for the condemnation of goods seized as forfeited shall be instituted by way of motion by an officer of customs, anything in the Customs Act 1966 to the contrary notwithstanding.

(b) Notice of the proceedings shall be given to such persons and in
such manner as the Court directs, and it shall be sufficient if public
notice is given by advertisement or otherwise at or near the place
of seizure.
(c) Any person claiming to be interested in the goods may appear to
oppose the application, and shall thereby become a party to the
proceedings.
(d) If any person appears to oppose the application the Court shall
hear and determine the matter and acquit or condemn the goods,
but if no person so appears judgment of condemnation shall be
given.
(e) In this regulation “goods” includes any boat, vehicle, or other thing
forfeited under the Customs Acts.

Jurisdiction of Commissioners

83 A Commissioner of the High Court shall have jurisdiction –

(a) In actions for the recovery of any debt or damages not exceeding
$1,500 in amount;
(b) In actions for the recovery of chattels not exceeding $1,500 in value;
(c) In criminal proceedings for any offence punishable by fine only;
(d) In criminal proceedings for any offence specified in Schedule 6;
(e) In civil proceedings under Part 23 of the Niue Act 1966.
292 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

84 A Commissioner of the High Court shall not have power to impose any fine exceeding 2 penalty units or to impose any term of imprisonment exceeding one year, whatever may be the maximum fine or term of imprisonment provided by law for the offence.

84A (1) A Commissioner and two Justices of the Peace sitting together shall have jurisdiction for the purpose of entering a conviction and imposing sentence only in criminal proceedings in charges, other than those specified in rule 83 (c) and (d) punishable by imprisonment for terms not exceeding ten years and in respect of which a plea of guilty has been entered by any defendant.

(2) No such sentence imposed shall have any effect unless and until the same is either confirmed or varied by the Chief Justice under rule 84B.

84B (1) The Chief Justice shall within one month of the receipt by him of a copy of the sentence imposed under rule 84A duly verified by the Registrar of the seal of the Court together with such information as he may require –

(a) Confirm the sentences as imposed; or
(b) Vary the sentence either by reducing or increasing the same in which
case the sentence as varied shall become the sentence of the Court;
or
(c) Order a rehearing of the proceedings in respect of which the sentence
has been imposed.
(2) The Chief Justice shall report in writing his decision on the certified
copy of the sentence and transmit the same to the court of origin which will either
cause the sentence as so confirmed or varied to be executed or grant a hearing if
so ordered.
(3) Any sentence fixed under this rule shall be deemed to be a final
judgment of the High Court for the purposes of article 55A of the Constitution.

84C (1) Pending sentence by the Court under rule 84A, the Court may remand the defendant at liberty or release him on bail subject to such conditions as it deems fit to appear for sentence when called upon by notice given not earlier than

48 hours of the date fixed for such purpose or remand him in custody pending sentence.
(2) Any period of remand in custody shall not be greater than 2 months.

85 Save as aforesaid, a Commissioner or a Commissioner and two Justices of the Peace sitting together shall not exercise any of the powers or functions, whether judicial or administrative, of a Judge of the Court.

86 In these Rules “Judge” includes a Commissioner of the High Court in respect of all matters within the jurisdiction of a Commissioner.

Criminal Proceedings

87 An information of a criminal offence may be in form 1 in Schedule 4.

88 The summons to the defendant in a criminal proceeding may be in form 2 in Schedule 4.

89 The summons to a witness in a criminal proceeding may be in form 3 in

Schedule 4.

Niue 293

90 A warrant issued by a Judge for the arrest of any person suspected of a criminal offence may be in form 4 in Schedule 4.

91 A warrant issued by a Judge of the Court for the arrest of an accused person may be in form 5 in Schedule 4.

92 A Judge’s warrant for the committal for trial or the release on bail of a person arrested on suspicion of a criminal offence may be in form 6 in Schedule 4.

93 The recognisance to be entered into by a prisoner admitted to bail by a

Judge may be in form 7 in Schedule 4.

94 Assessors in a criminal trial may be appointed by warrant in form 8 in

Schedule 4.

95 A conviction may be formally drawn up and sealed in form 9 in Schedule

4.

96 A warrant of commitment to prison for default in the payment of a fine may be in form 10 in Schedule 4.

97 A search warrant may be in form 11 in Schedule 4.

98 The remuneration and allowances payable to an assessor in a criminal trial shall be such as the Court in each case thinks fit and directs, but shall not exceed

$3 per day in addition to travelling expenses actually incurred and paid.

99 The expenses of a witness at a criminal trial, to be certified by the Judge for payment out of Treasury, shall be such as the Judge thinks fit, not exceed $3 a day in addition to travelling expenses actually incurred and paid.

Miscellaneous

100 There shall be payable in respect of proceedings in the Court the fees set

forth in Schedule 5.

101 If it appears to the satisfaction of the Court that any party is unable or ought not to be called upon to pay any of the fees mentioned in Schedule 5, the Court may dispense with the payment or may reduce the amount .

101A In any appeal from the judgment of a Commissioner of the High Court to a

Judge of the High Court –
(a) If it appears to any Commissioner or Registrar of the Court, or to
any Justices of the Peace acting together, that the appellant is unable
to pay the fees payable in respect of the appeal, the Commissioner
or Registrar or Justices of the Peace may dispense with the payment
of the fees or may reduce the amount thereof;
(b) If the appellant succeeds in his appeal, the fees paid by him shall be
returned to him.

102 The Court or the proper officer thereof may refuse to take any step in the course of any proceedings until the proper fee therefor, together with all other fees already due and unpaid in respect of the same proceedings, have been fully paid.

294 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

103 Such variations in the forms prescribed in the Schedules may be made as the circumstances of any particular case may require.

104 All documents filed in or issued from the Court may be either in English or in Niuean.

105 Non-compliance with any of these Rules shall not render the proceedings void, but the proceedings may be set aside, either wholly or in part, as irregular, or amended, or otherwise dealt with in such manner and on such terms as the Court may deem just.

106 The jurisdiction of the Court in any proceeding may be exercised from time to time by any of the Judges of the Court and at any time or place, notwithstanding that the proceeding may not have been duly continued by adjournment from time to time or from place to place.

107 (1) If at the time and place of trial stated in any summons or notice to a defendant or other party in any civil or criminal proceeding, or in any summons to a witness, or at the time and place to which the trial or hearing of any action, prosecution, or other proceeding has been adjourned, a Judge of the High Court is not present, a Registrar, if present, may adjourn the Court to another time and to the same or any other place.

(2) If within one hour after the time so stated in any such summons or notice, or appointed by any adjournment, a Judge is not present and no adjournment by the Registrar has taken place, the Court shall be deemed to be adjourned to the same place on the next succeeding day at the hour stated in the summons or notice, or at any other hour so appointed by adjournment, and so on.
(3) On every such adjournment the summons or notice shall have the same
effect as if the time and place to which the Court is adjourned had been set forth in
the summons or notice.

––––––––––––––––––––

Niue 295

SCHEDULES

In the High Court of Niue

SCHEDULE 1

Between A.B., of Niue, Plaintiff, and

C.D., of Niue , Defendant.

The plaintiff claims the sum of $20 due to him as the price of goods sold and delivered by him to the defendant, particulars whereof are as follows:

[Or]

The plaintiff claims $100 as damages for an assault committed against him by the defendant

on the ............................ day of ............................20 ....., at .............................

[Or]

The plaintiff claims possession of certain chattels wrongfully detained by the defendant –

namely,

. . . . . . [Or]

The plaintiff claims the sum of $200 as damages for a breach of contract committed by the defendant under the following circumstances: [Setting out the facts].

––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 2

Form 1

SUMMONS TO A DEFENDANT

In the High Court of Niue

Between A.B., of............................, Plaintiff, and

C.D., of............................

Defendant.

You are hereby summoned to appear and defend this action at the trial thereof before the

High Court on ............................, the ............................ day of ............................, 20........, at

............................o’clock in the ............................noon, at [Place of trial]. A copy of the statement

Between A.B., of ............................, Plaintiff, and

C.D., of ............................, Defendant.

You are hereby summoned to appear before the High Court at ............................on

............................, the ............................ day of ............................, 20........, at ............................

o’clock in the ............................noon, there to give evidence as to the matters in question in

this action; and you are further required to bring with you and produce to the Court the

following documents, namely:

Herein fail not at your peril.

............................ [SEAL] Registrar. To............................

296 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

In the High Court of Niue

Form 3

WRIT OF SALE

Between A.B., of ............................

Plaintiff,

and

C.D., of............................,

Defendant.

You are hereby directed to make of the chattels of ............................, the above-named defendant, the sum of ............................, which the above-named plaintiff has recovered against him in this Court by virtue of a judgment given on the ............................ day of

............................, 20......, (together with interest upon the said sum at the rate of $12 for every $200 by the year from the said ............................ day of ............................, 20........), and cause that money (with such interest as aforesaid) immediately after the execution hereof to be rendered to the said plaintiff.

Dated this............................day of ............................, 20.........

[Seal]

To [Officer of the Court or a constable].

............................

Registrar.

In the High Court of Niue

Form 4

WRIT OF POSSESSION

Between A.B., of ............................, Plaintiff, and

C.D., of ............................

Defendant.

You are hereby directed to deliver to ............................, the above-named plaintiff, possession of all that parcel of land being [Here describe the land so as to identify it], in pursuance of a judgment obtained in this Court by the said plaintiff against the said defendant on the

............................ day of ............................, 20.........

Dated the ............................day of ............................, 20 .......

............................ [Seal] Registrar. To [Officer of the Court or a constable]

Form 5

MOTION FOR ORDER FOR PAYMENT OF JUDGEMENT DEBT

In the High Court of Niue

Between A.B., of ............................, Judgment creditor, and

C.D., of............................

Judgment debtor.

The above-named judgment creditor makes application for an order under section 94 of the Niue Act 1966 for the payment by the above-named judgment debtor of the sum of

............................, for which judgment was obtained in this Court on the ............................day of ............................, 20......., and which is still unpaid.

Niue 297

In the High Court of Niue

Form 6

JUDGMENT SUMMONS

Between A.B., of ............................, Judgment creditor, and

C.D., of ............................, Judgment debtor.

Take notice that you are hereby summoned to appear before this Court at ............................on

............................, the ............................day of ............................, 20.........., at

............................o’clock in the ............................noon, to show cause why an order under

section 94 of the Niue Act 1966 should not be made against you for the payment of the

sum of ............................ due by you to the above-named judgment creditor under a

judgment obtained against you in this Court on the ............................day of ............................,

20.........

For disobedience to any order which may be so made against you you will be liable to

imprisonment.

............................ [SEAL] Registrar To the above-named judgment debtor.

In the High Court of the Niue

Form 7

PROBATE

In the matter of the will of ............................, deceased.

Be it known to all men that on this ............................day of ............................, in the year

20........, the last will and testament of ............................, deceased, a copy of which is hereunto

annexed; has been exhibited, read, and proved before this Court and administration of

the estate of the deceased has been and is hereby granted to ............................, the executor

in the said will and testament named, being first sworn faithfully to execute the same.

Given under the seal of the High Court of Niue at ............................, this ............................

day of ............................20 .........

[SEAL]

............................

Registrar.

Form 8

LETTERS OF ADMINISTRATION WITHOUT A WILL

In the High Court of Niue

In the matter of the estate of ............................, deceased intestate.

To............................, widow [or as the case may be] of deceased.

Whereas the said ............................lately departed this life intestate: You are therefore by

these presents constituted administrator of the estate of the said deceased, you having

been first sworn well and faithfully to administer the same.

Given under the seal of the High Court of Niue at ............................, this ............................day

of ............................ 20......

[SEAL]

Form 9

LETTERS OF ADMINISTRATION WITH THE WILL ANNEXED

In the High Court of Niue

In the matter of the will ............................, deceased. To............................, widow [or as the case may be] of deceased.

Whereas the said ............................lately departed this life leaving a will which has been duly proved in this Court and a coy of which is annexed: and whereas no executor is named in that will [or the executors named in that will have not applied for probate]: you

298 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

are therefore by these presents constituted administrator with the will annexed of the estate of the said deceased, you having been first sworn well and faithfully to administer the same.

Given under the seal of the High Court of Niue at ............................, this ............................

day of ............................, 20..........

[SEAL]

In the High Court of Niue

Form 10

ADMINISTRATION BOND

In the matter of the estate of ............................, deceased.

Know all men by these presents that we ............................are held and firmly bound unto the Registrar of the High Court at Niue in the sum of ............................, for which payment well and truly to be made to the said Registrar we do and each of us does bind ourselves and each of us, and the executors and administrators of us and of each of us, jointly and severally, firmly by these presents.

Whereas by order of this Court of the ............................ day of ............................20....., it is ordered that letters of administration of the estate of ............................, deceased, be granted to the said ............................ on his giving security for the due administration thereof: and whereas ............................has sworn that to the best of his knowledge and belief the said estate is under the value of $.............................

Now, the condition of the above-written bond is that if the above-bounden

............................well and truly administers the said estate according to law and renders

to this Court a true and just account of his administration on or before the

............................day of ............................20.........., then this bond shall be void and of none

effect, but otherwise shall remain in full force.

Signed the ............................ day of ............................, 20.........., in the presence of –

............................

In the High Court of Niue

–––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 3

FORMS OF MOTIONS

In the matter of the will of A.B., of ............................ deceased.

The applicant, C.D., of ............................, claims probate of the will of the above-named

deceased, who died at ............................on the ............................day of ............................,

20.........., on the ground that he is the executor named in the said will.

[Or]

In the High Court of Niue

In the matter of A.B., a minor.

The applicant, C.D., of ............................, claims the custody of A.B., a minor, on the ground that the minor is the child of the applicant and that possession of the minor is wrongfully detained by E.F. of ............................

In the High Court of Niue

[Or]

In the matter of A.B., a prisoner.

The applicant, A.B., of ............................, claims release from detention in the prison at

............................, on the ground that he is there detained unlawfully under a warrant

issued without jurisdiction.

In the High Court of Niue

[Or]

In the matter of A.B., a person of unsound mind.

The applicant, C.D., Chief Medical Officer of Niue, claims an order committing the said

A.B. to medical custody on the ground that he is of unsound mind.

[Or]

The applicant, A.B. of ............................, claims a maintenance order against the defendant

in favour of the applicant and her children, on the ground that the defendant, being the

husband of the applicant, has failed to provide her and her children with adequate

maintenance.

Niue 299

In the High Court of Niue

SCHEDULE 4

Form 1

INFORMATION

INFORMATION

Between A.B. Informant, and

C.D., Defendant.

A.B., of ............................, comes before me ............................, a Judge of this Court, and informs me (on oath) that he has just cause to suspect and does suspect that C.D., of

............................, did on the ............................ day of ............................, 20........, at

............................, steal [Describe the article stolen], being the property of E.F. and of a value

not exceeding $4 [or not exceeding $100, or exceeding $100]; and also that the said C.D.

did, on the ............................day of ............................, 20........., at ............................, break and

enter the dwellinghouse of E.F. with intent to commit theft therein.

[Signature of Informant.]

Taken before me, at ............................. this ............................ day of ............................, 20...........

............................

A Judge of the High Court.

In the High Court of Niue

Form 2

SUMMONS TO ACCUSED

Between A.B., Informant, and

C.D., Defendant.

Whereas an information has been laid against you by the above-named informant that on the ............................ day of ............................, 20.........., at ............................ you did [Setting our charge as stated in information]:

You are therefore summoned to appear before this Court on ............................, the

............................ day of ............................, 20.........., at ............................ o’clock in the

............................ noon, at [Place of trial], there to answer the charge so made against you.

Dated this ............................ day of ............................ 20...........

............................

[Seal] Judge of the High Court.

To the above-named defendant.

Form 3

SUMMONS TO WITNESS IN CRIMINAL PROCEEDINGS

In the High Court of Niue

Between A.B., Informant, and

C.D., Defendant. Whereas an information has been laid against the above-named defendant that on the

............................ day of ............................, 20.........., at ............................, he did [Setting out charge as in information]: And whereas it has been made to appear to me that you are able to give evidence relative to the charge so made.

You are therefore hereby summoned to appear before the High Court on ............................, the ............................ day of ............................, 20.........., at ............................ o’clock in the

............................ noon, at [Place of trial], there to testify what you know concerning the said charge [and you are hereby required to bring with you and produce to the Court the following documents, namely ............................].

Herein fail not at your peril.

[SEAl]

To [Name and description of witness]

............................ Judge [or Registrar] of the High Court.

300 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Form 4

MAGISTRATES WARRANT FOR ARREST OF ACCUSED

Whereas it has been made to appear to me that C.D., of ............................, is justly suspected of the murder of E.F. [or of having stolen the goods of E.F., or otherwise setting out the offence]:

You are therefore hereby authorised and directed forthwith to arrest the said C.D. and bring him before a Judge of the High Court of Niue, there to be dealt with according to law; and for so doing this shall be your warrant.

Dated this............................ day of ............................ 20..........

To all constables in Niue.

............................ Cabinet [or Registrar

of the High Court, or Medical

Officer, or as the case may be]

Form 5

JUDGES WARRANT FOR ARREST OF ACCUSED

In the High Court of Niue

Between A.B., Informant

and

C.D., Defendant

Whereas information has been laid against the above-named defendant that on the

............................ day of ............................, at............................, he did [Setting out charge as in

information]:

You are hereby required and authorised to arrest the said defendant and bring him

forthwith before a Judge of this Court, there to answer the charge so made against him,

and for so doing this shall be your warrant.

Dated this ............................ day of ............................, 20.........

[SEAL]

To all constables in Niue.

............................ Judge of the High Court.

Form 6

WARRANT FOR COMMITTAL TO PRISON OR RELEASE ON BAIL

Whereas A.B. has been brought before me in custody charged with the offence of stealing

the goods of C.D. [or as the case may be]:

Now, therefore, I hereby commit the said A.B. to the prison at ............................, there to

await his trial for the said offence before the High Court of Niue.

[Or]

Now, therefore, I hereby admit the said A.B. to bail, with two sureties [or as the case may

be] in the sum of $............................ to appear before the High Court of Niue at the next

sitting of that Court held by a Judge thereof [or by a Commissioner thereof] in the place

of............................ for trial for the said offence.

Dated this ............................ day of ............................, 20...........

Cabinet [or Registrar of the High Court, or Medical Officer, or as the case may be.]

Niue 301

Form 7

RECOGNISANCE OF PRISONER ADMITTED TO BAIL

Know all men by these presents that we [Defendant and his sureties] are held and firmly

bound unto the Government of Niue in the sum of $............................ , for which payment

to be well and truly made to the Government of Niue we do and each of us doth bind

ourselves and each of us, and the executors and administrators of us and of each of us,

jointly and severally, firmly by these presents.

Whereas the above-named defendant has been arrested on a charge of ............................,

and has been admitted to bail to await his trial for that offence before the High Court of

Niue.

Now, therefore, the condition of this bond is that if the said defendant appears before the

said Court in due course for trial for the said offence at the next sitting of the said Court

held by a Judge thereof [or by a Commissioner thereof] in the place of ............................,

then this bond shall be void and of no effect, but otherwise shall remain in full force.

Signed this ............................day of ............................, 20...........

[SEAL]

Form 8

WARRANT OF APPOINTMENT OF ASSESSORS

In the High Court of Niue

............................

Judge.

Between A.B., Informant, and

C.D., Defendant. Whereas C.D. is accused in this Court of the murder of E.F. [or as the case may be]: And whereas (in pursuance of an order made by this Court in that behalf) the trial of the said accused must take place before assessors:

Now, therefore, I do hereby appoint as assessors for the said trial the persons following, being duly qualified by law in that behalf............................

Dated this ............................day of ............................, 20...........

............................

[SEAL]

............................

Judge.

In the High Court of Niue

Form 9

CONVICTION

Between A.B., Informant, and

C.D., Defendant.

Be it remembered that on the ............................ day of ............................, 20.........., at

............................, C.D., ............................, is convicted before this Court ............................ on

the information of A.B., ............................, for that on the ............................ day of

............................, 20........., at ............................, he did [Set out the offence]; and it is adjudged

that the said C.D. for his said offence shall be imprisoned in the prison at ............................

for the space of ............................

Given under my hand and the seal of the said Court, the day and year first above written.

............................

[SEAL] Judge of the High Court.

302

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Form 10

WARRANT OF COMMITMENT FOR DEFAULT IN PAYMENT OF FINE

In the High Court of Niue

Between A.B., Informant, and

C.D., Defendant. Whereas on the ............................ day of ............................, 20.........., the above-named defendant was convicted in this Court of the offence of ............................, and sentenced to pay a fine of ............................: And whereas the said fine remains unpaid:

It is ordered that the said defendant be imprisoned for the term of ............................ from the date of this order, or until the said fine shall be sooner paid.

Dated this ............................ day of ............................, 20..........

............................ [SEAL] Judge.

Form 11

SEARCH WARRANT

Whereas it has been made to appear to me, on the oath of A.B., that there is reasonable

ground for believing that there are in the dwellinghouse of C.D. (or as the case may be) at

............................ certain goods in respect of which an offence has been committed against

the Customs Act 1966 (or as the case may be):

Now therefore, I hereby authorise you to search such dwellinghouse for such goods and

to seize the same and bring them before me; and for so doing this shall be your warrant.

Dated this ............................ day of ............................, 20..........

To E.F., Constable.

............................ Officer of Customs [or as the case may be]

––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE 5

COURT FEES

Civil Proceedings

1 In Actions where a sum of money or any property is claimed–

Sum of Money or Value of the Land or Chattel Claimed

Not Not Not

Not

Not

Exceeding Exceeding Exceeding

Exceeding

Exceeding

Exceeding

$20

$40

$100

$200

$500

$500

(1)

Filing statement of claim

and issue of summons

0.30

0.50

1.00

1.50

2.00

2.00

(2)

Filing counterclaim

(on amount of counterclaim)

0.20

0.30

0.50

0.76

1.00

1.25

(3)

Hearing or rehearing and

judgment (on claim or

counterclaim)

0.30

0.50

1.00

1.50

2.00

2.50

2 In all other actions and proceedings $ (1) Filing and hearing statement of claim and issue of summons 1.00 (2) Service of any summons, notice, or other process 0.20 (3) For each additional summons in any proceedings 0.20 (4) Sealing of any judgment, order, writ of execution, or other

document (other than a summons) 0.30 (5) Copy of any document or notes of evidence – per folio of 72 words

(minimum 3 folios) 0.10 (6) Filing of any notice or motion, affidavit, petition (other than

a petition for divorce), or other document 0.30 (7) Hearing of any motion or petition (other than a petition for divorce) 0.50 (8) Filing petition for divorce or nullity of marriage and supporting

affidavit 1.00

Niue 303

(9) Hearing of petition for divorce or nullity of marriage 2.00 (10) Stating case for High Court 2.00 (11) Hearing application for leave to appeal to High Court 1.00 (12) Sealing order granting leave to appeal to High Court 2.00 (13) Filing motion for probate or letters of administration 1.00 (14) Sealing any probate or letters or administration

Where the net value of the estate does not exceed $1,000 2.00

Where the net value of the estate exceeds $1,000 but does not

exceed $2,000 2.10

Where the net value of the estate exceeds $2,000 4.00

(15) Execution of any writ of execution or warrant 0.30

No fees shall be payable in proceedings under Part 23 of the Niue Act 1966

Criminal Proceedings

No fees shall be payable in any criminal proceedings commenced by the

information of a constable or any other employee of the Niue Public Service.

In all other cases a fee of $1 shall be payable on the information. If the accused

is convicted, the fee so paid shall be refunded to the informant.

Appeals from Commissioners of the High Court (Whether in Civil or Criminal

Proceedings)

$

(1) Filing notice of appeal 0.50 (2) Hearing of appeal 1.00

No fees shall be payable in respect of appeals in proceedings commenced by a constable or any other employee of the Niue Public Service.

SCHEDULE 6

Rule 83 (d)

Commissioners of the High Court shall have jurisdiction in all or any of the following criminal offences specified in the following sections of the Niue Act 1966:

130 188 223

150 192 (1) (a) and (b) 224

152 194 225

153 198 226

155 199 227

157 200

160 201

166 202

167 203

168 206

173 210

174 211

175 213

176 214

177 215

178 216

179 217

182 218

183 219

185 220

186 221

222

––––––––––––––––––––

304 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

HIGH COURT RULES AMENDMENT NO. 2

APPEALS FROM COMMISSIONERS

1 Any party to any proceedings, whether civil or criminal, before a Commissioner of the High Court may appeal from the judgment of the Commissioner to a Judge of the High Court.

2 (1) Notice of appeal shall be filed in Court within 21 days after the delivery of the judgment appealed from.

(2) Any written notice which shows an intention or desire to appeal shall be sufficient.

3 Upon the filing of such notice, the Commissioner shall, unless a Judge makes an order to the contrary, grant a stay of execution of the judgment appealed from, and if the appellant is in custody shall release him therefrom on bail pending the determination of the appeal.

4 Any person so released on bail may at any time and for any reason that a Judge thinks sufficient be arrested by warrant and committed to prison there to undergo his sentence.

5 Any period during which an appellant has been so at large on bail shall not be computed as part of any term of imprisonment to which he has been sentenced.

6 Every such appeal shall be by way of rehearing.

7 Before hearing any appeal a Judge may impose such conditions as he shall think fit as to security for costs of the appeal or for performance of the judgment thereon.

8 If the appellant does not with due diligence prosecute his appeal, or perform or observe any of the conditions imposed by a Judge as mentioned in clause 7, a Judge may dismiss the appeal; and the costs thereof, and any security entered into by the appellant, shall be dealt with in such manner as the Judge directs.

9 (1) The appellant may at any time before hearing discontinue his appeal, either wholly or as to any ground thereof, by filing in Court a notice of discontinuance.

(2) If the appeal is wholly discontinued, the judgment appealed from may immediately be carried into effect.

10 The Commissioner may at any stage of the proceedings adjourn any case for hearing and determination by a Judge.

––––––––––––––––––––

HIGH COURT RULES AMENDMENT NO. 3

1 These are the High Court Rules 1916 Amendment No 3 and shall be read together with and deemed part of the High Court Rules 1916 (the principal rules).

which the term occurs is applicable to them.

Niue 305

4 (1) Every proceeding for a decree of divorce or nullity of marriage shall be commenced by filing a petition in the Court.

(2) The petition shall be in accordance with form 1 in Schedule 1 and shall set out the grounds for divorce or nullity of marriage.

5 Every person seeking a decree of divorce or of nullity of marriage shall append to the petition an affidavit in form 2 in Schedule 1, verifying the same so far as the deponent is able to do so.

6 (1) There shall be annexed to every petition and every copy thereof a summons to the respondent in accordance with form 3 in Schedule 1 and the original shall be filed in the Court.

(2) (a) The summons shall specify, inter alia, the sitting of the Court fixed by the

Registrar for the hearing of the petition.

(b) In making that fixture the Registrar shall take into account the distance of

the place of residence of the respondent from the place where the petition

is to be heard and all other relevant circumstances, and the sitting so fixed

shall not without leave of the Court be on a date less than 21 days from

the date of filing of the petition.

7 (1) Service of a petition shall be effected by personally delivering to each respondent a copy of the petition under seal of the Court with a copy, signed by the Registrar, of the summons to the respondent required by these Rules to be annexed to the petition.

(2) Personal service shall in no case be effected by the petitioner, but the petitioner may be present when such service is effected.

(3) A petition for a decree of divorce or nullity of marriage may be served out of

Niue by leave of the Court.

8 (1) Each respondent who resides within Niue may, within 14 days after service of the petition on him or her, file an answer thereto. Where a respondent resides beyond Niue, the time after service within which he or she may file an answer to the petition shall, on application by the petitioner, be fixed by the Court.

(2) An answer shall be in accordance with form 4 in Schedule 1.

9 A respondent who fails to file an answer within the time hereinbefore prescribed, or within any extended time allowed for that purpose, shall not be entitled to be heard on the petition, without leave of the Court, granted on such terms as the Court thinks fit, except on questions of costs, custody of children, or maintenance.

10 (1) Where a respondent intends to apply for relief, the answer of that respondent shall conclude with a prayer for the relief to which he or she claims to be entitled.

(2) An answer may be amended by leave of the Court, by adding such a prayer at or before the trial.

11 The Court may at any time order further particulars to be given of any matters pleaded.

12 (1) (a) Every application for custody of children or for maintenance shall be to the Court by notice under form 5 in Schedule 1.

(b) Any such application may be made by a respondent, whether or not he or she has filed or intends to file an answer to the original petition.

(2) An order for custody of children may be made upon the hearing of any petition in which a prayer for such custody is contained, without the necessity of complying with the requirements of subclause (1).

(3) Where the parties are agreed upon the terms of any order granting custody of children or maintenance, the order may, by consent of the parties, be included in the decree, without the necessity of complying with the requirements of subclause (1).

306 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

13 Any application to the Court, or to a Judge, whether in Court or Chambers, not required to be made by petition or by notice of application for custody of children or for maintenance, may be made by motion.

14 In matters for which no specific provision is made in this Part in respect of matrimonial causes, the general provisions of the principal Rules providing for the conduct of actions before the High Court, as far as they are applicable and with the necessary modifications shall apply.

Rule 4

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE

FORMS IN PROCEEDINGS FOR DIVORCE OR NULLITY OF MARRIAGE

Form 1

In the High Court of Niue

(In Divorce)

Between A.B., of ............................[Occupation], Petitioner,

and C.D., of ............................[Occupation], Respondent

PETITION

The petitioner prays for a divorce from the respondent on the following grounds:

[Here state the grounds for divorce.]

Dated this ............................day of ............................20..........

............................ Signature of Petitioner

Rule 5

In the High Court of Niue

Form 2

(In Divorce)

Between A.B., of ............................[Occupation], Petitioner,

and C.D., of ............................[Occupation], Resondent.

I, A.B.., of ............................[Occupation], make oath and say –

1 I am applying for a divorce from my wife (husband) named: [Full name].

2 We were married at ............................ by ............................ of the ............................Church,

on the ............................day of ............................19..........

3 There are ............................children of the marriage, namely: [Full names].

4 The grounds upon which I am applying for the divorce are: [Set out grounds],

and the following are the facts concerning the same: [Set out proof fully].

5 I am a native of ............................and the said ............................is a native of ............................

Sworn at ............................by the above-named A.B. this ............................day of

............................20..........

A Solicitor of the High Court

(or A Registrar of the High Court.)

(or A Postmaster.)

(or A collector of customs.)

(or A medical officer)

Niue 307

Rule 6 (1)

In the High Court of Niue

Form 3

(In Divorce)

Between A.B., of .......................... [Occupation], Petitioner,

and C.D., of ............................[Occupation], Respondent.

SUMMONS

You are hereby summoned, if you wish to defend these proceedings, to appear at the

trial thereof before the High Court at ............................at the first sitting of this Court for

the trial of civil proceedings after the expiration of ............................ days from but exclusive

of the date of service upon you of the petition in these proceedings.

A copy of the petition and of the supporting affidavit in these proceedings is annexed.

hereto.

Dated this............................ day of ............................20..........

(SEAL)

To the above-named Respondent.

............................

Registrar.

Rule 8 (2)

In the High Court of Niue

Form 4

(In Divorce)

Between A.B., of ............................[Occupation], Petitioner,

and C.D., of ............................[ Occupation], Respondent

Answer

I, C.D., ...........................of ...........................[Occupation], the above-named respondent, make

oath and say –

1 I was this day served with a petition for divorce and affidavit in support thereof.

2 I admit (or deny) the charges made against me in the petition and affidavit. [Or set out

which are admitted or denied.]

3 I (do not) object to a divorce being granted.

4 I wish the children to remain the custody of ...........................

Sworn at ........................... by the above-named A.B. this ........................... day of

...........................20..........

A Solicitor of the High Court (or A Registrar of the High Court).

(or A Postmaster.)

(or A collector of customs.)

(or A medical officer.)

In the High Court of Niue

Form 5

(In Divorce)

Between A.B., of ...........................[Occupation], Petitioner,

and C.D., of ...........................[Occupation], Respondent.

Application for Custody of Children (or Maintenance)

Take notice that the Petitioner (Respondent) intends to apply to the Court for an order for

the custody of the children of the marriage (or for a maintenance order against the

Respondent (Petitioner)).

Dated this ...........................day of ...........................20..........

To the above-named Respondent (Petitioner).

........................... Petitioner (Respondent).

308 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

HIGH COURT RULES AMENDMENT No. 5

1 These are the High Court Rules 1916, Amendment No. 5 and shall be read together with and deemed part of the High Court Rules1916 and its amendments.

2 The Commissioner of the High Court shall have jurisdiction in all or any of the offences specified hereunder –

(1) The Niue Act 1966, s188 (in cases to which s192(1)(a) and (b) apply) and s193

(1);

(2) Section 39 of the Transport Act 1965;

(3) Any other offences contained in any law for which the maximum term of

imprisonment provided does not exceed 3 years.

3 (1) In any proceeding commenced before a Commissioner exercising jurisdiction conferred on him by rule 2 the Commissioner may, at any time before the defendants have been sentenced or otherwise dealt with, decline to deal further with the offence and require that it shall be dealt with by a Judge and may endorse on the information a certificate to that effect.

(2) If the defendant is being convicted or has pleaded guilty the Commissioner shall remand him for sentence by a Judge and for that purpose, if it is expedient and in the interest of justice so to do, may make an order accordingly under these Rules.

(3) In any other case, the Judge will deal with the case in all respects as a rehearing.

Niue 309

LAND COURT RULES 1969

1969 – 1 November 1969

1

Title 25 Recording proceedings

2

Interpretation 26 Powers of Court

3

[Spent] 27 Evidence of witnesses

4

Forms 28 Expenses of witnesses

5

Attestation 29 Summons to witness

6

Failure to comply with rules 30 Application for rehearing

7

Service of notices 31 Submission of drafts of orders

8

Court office 32 Form of order

9

Court records 33 Amendment of defects

10

Times and places of sittings 34 Amendment of records

11

Cancelling, opening and adjourning 35 Costs

sittings 36 Security for costs

12

Commencement of proceedings 37 Charging orders for costs

13

Register of applications 38 Powers and duties of Chief Justice in

14

Annexure of documents to applications relation to notices of appeal

15

Definitions of person under disability 39 Appeal from Commissioner

16

Application on behalf of a person under 40 Withdrawal of appeal

disability 41 Appeals to be by way of rehearing

17

Guardian ad litem 42 Court of Appeal

18

Restrictions on persons under the age of 16 43 Exemptions from payment of fees

years and on persons of unsound mind 44 Scale of fees

19

Registrar to give notice 45 Reduction and remission of fees

20

No notice required for ex parte applications 46 Certified and sealed copies

21

Court may direct that notice be given 47 Arrangement of business

22

Attendance of Clerk of the Court 48 Matters not provided for

23

Persons affected by applications

24

Senior Judge to preside at sitting of Land SCHEDULES

Court

––––––––––––––––––––

1

Title

These are the Land Court Rules 1969.

2

Interpretation

(1) In these Rules –

“Act” means the Niue Act 1966;

“applicant” includes an appellant;

“application” includes a notice of appeal;

“Court” means the High Court or the Court of Appeal as the case may

require;

“Commissioner” means a Commissioner of the High Court;

“Judge” means a Judge of the High Court or a Judge of the Court of Appeal

as the case may require;

“party” means any person who has made an application to the Court; and

includes any person whose rights or interests are affected by an

application or by any order made pursuant to an application; and also

includes any Leveki Mangafaoa or trustee in respect of any such person;

310 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
“Registrar” means a Registrar of the High Court or of the Court of Appeal as the case may require, and includes a Deputy Registrar.
(2) A reference to a numbered form is a reference to the form so numbered in Schedule 1.
as the case may require, and, if no form is prescribed by these rules, such form shall be used as a Judge or the Registrar may direct or approve.
(2) In any case an equivalent form in the Niuean language may be used, and shall be sufficient.

5 Attestation

Where these rules require that the signature of any person to any application
or other document shall be attested, that signature must be attested by any person
mentioned in section 720 of the Act.

6 Failure to comply with rules

A failure to comply with these rules shall not render any proceedings void
unless the Court so directs; but any such proceedings may be set aside, either
wholly or in part, as irregular, or may be amended or otherwise dealt with in such
manner and upon such terms as the Court may direct.

7 Service of notices

(1) (a) Subject to rules 12(5)(f), 23(2) and 29(4) a notice or other document
required or authorised by these Rules to be served on any person
may be delivered to him either personally or, where that person is
in Niue, by posting it by letter to that person at his last-known place
of abode or business in Niue.
(b) A notice or other document so posted shall be deemed to have been
served at the time when the letter would in the ordinary course of
post be delivered.
(2) (a) If the person is absent from Niue, the notice or other document
may be delivered as aforesaid to his agent in Niue.
(b) If he is deceased, the notice may be delivered as aforesaid to his
personal representative in Niue.
(3) If the person is not known, or is absent from Niue and has no known
agent in Niue, or is dead and has no personal representative in Niue, the notice or
other document shall be delivered in such a manner as may be directed by an
order of a Judge.
(4) Notwithstanding rule 7(1)-(3), a Judge may in any case make an order
directing the manner in which a notice or document (other than a summons to a
witness to show cause) is to be delivered, or dispensing with the delivery.

8 Court office

(1) There shall be an office of the Court situated at such place in Niue as
Cabinet appoints.
(2) The Court office shall be open for business from 10am to 3pm on every
day, not being a Saturday, Sunday, or Court holiday.
(3) The administration work of the Court shall be carried out at the Court
office.

Niue 311

9 Court records

The records and other documents of the Court shall be deposited and kept
at the Court office in the custody of the Registrar and, except as provided in these
rules, none of those records or other documents shall be taken out of the Court
office save with the leave or pursuant to the direction of a Judge.

10 Times and places of sittings

(1) The Court shall sit at such times and places as the Chief Justice appoints.
(2) The Registrar shall cause the times and places of the sittings of the
Court to be duly and conveniently advertised in the Gazette.
(3) Notwithstanding paragraphs (1) and (2), a sitting of the High Court
may be held at any time and place appointed by a Judge, without notice of that
sitting being given in the Gazette by the Registrar, but no matter shall be heard or
determined at any such sitting other than a matter of which due notice has been
given to the parties or which, under the Act or these Rules, may be heard and
determined ex parte.

11 Cancelling, opening, and adjourning sittings

(1) The Chief Justice may, at any time before the commencement of any
sitting of the Court, cancel the sitting.
(2) Any Judge, or any person authorised in that behalf by a Judge, may
open a sitting of the Court.
(3) After the opening of any sitting of the Court, the presiding Judge or, in
his absence, any person authorised in that behalf by him, may adjourn the sitting
or any part of the business notified to be dealt with at the sitting, either sine die or
to some other time or place.
(4) The Registrar shall give notice of any cancellation or adjournment made
under this rule to such persons and in such manner as a Judge may direct.
(5) Any matter adjourned sine die may be heard at such time and place and
upon such notice to the parties and others as a Judge may direct.

12 Commencement of proceedings

(1) All proceedings in the High Court shall be commenced by application.
(2) An application to the High Court shall be in form 1.
(3) All proceedings in the Court of Appeal shall be commenced by notice
of appeal.
(4) A notice of appeal shall be in form 2, and shall be attested.
(5) Every application shall be in writing, and shall set forth, in a legible
fashion –
agent.
(a) The full names, address, and occupation of the applicant;
(b) Each statutory provision, section of the Act and rule in reliance upon
which the application is made;
(c) The nature of the order sought by the applicant;
(d) The grounds on which the application is made;
(e) The full names of the person filing the application;
(f) An address, in Niue, at which notices and other documents relating
to the application may be served on the applicant, which address
shall, for the purposes of rule 7 (1) be deemed to be the last-known
place of business in Niue of the applicant.
(6) Every application shall be signed by the applicant or his duly authorised
(7) Every ex parte application shall be marked “ex parte”.
312 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(8) An application shall be filed by delivering it at the Court office to the Registrar, or to some other officer of the Court duly authorised in writing by the Registrar to receive it.
(9) No application for the partition of Niuean land shall be heard or determined by the Court until all previous partition orders made with respect to the same land have been sealed and signed.
(10) Every application shall have annexed thereto all documents that are, by the provisions of any Act required to be filed with the application.
(11) An application for an interlocutory injunction may be made ex parte.
(12) Any party to any proceedings may apply ex parte to the Court for an
interlocutory order for directions or with reference to any other interlocutory matter
in the proceedings.
(13) If, in the opinion of the Registrar, an application is not properly made,
he may refuse to accept it, unless he is directed by a Judge to accept it.

13 Register of applications

(1) The Registrar shall keep a register of applications.
(2) The Registrar shall cause to be recorded in the register and upon each
application accepted by him –
(a) The date on which the application was filed;
(b) The date on which any fee payable in respect of the filing of the
application was paid.
(3) The Registrar shall cause a distinctive number to be inscribed on each
application, and that number shall correspond with the number of the application
in the register.

14 Annexure of documents to applications

The Registrar shall cause to be endorsed on or annexed to each application
all such particulars and extracts from the records of the Court as may be necessary,
in his opinion, to enable the Court to deal effectively with the application at the
hearing of the application.

15 Definition of person under disability

(1) In this rule and in rules 16 and 17, “person under disability” means –
(a) Any person who is under the age of 16 years; or
(b) Any person who is unable, wholly or partly to manage his own
affairs by reason of –
(i) his age; or
(ii) his physical or mental infirmity; or
(iii) his intemperate or recklessly extravagant habits; or
(iv) his improvidence; or
(c) Any person who is of unsound mind; or
(d) Any person who is in prison or other place of detention; or
(e) Any other person who is, or whose interests are, in the opinion of a
Judge, in need of special care and protection which that person is
unable himself personally to provide.

Niue 313

16 Application on behalf of a person under disability

(1) (a) Any person who desires to make an application to the Court on
behalf of a person under disability may apply ex parte to a Judge for
an order that the applicant be appointed the agent of the person
under disability to make the application on behalf of the person
under disability.
(b) With any application for such an order there shall be filed a draft of
the application which the agent (if appointed) desires to make on
behalf of the person under disability.
(2) On the hearing of any such application for appointment, the Judge may,
by order –
(a) Refuse the application; or
(b) Grant the application upon such conditions as to the liability of the
agent for the costs of the person under disability, the giving of
security for those costs, or otherwise, as the Judge thinks fit, and
the agent shall not act on behalf of the person under disability
contrary to those conditions and shall, on filing any application on
behalf of the person under disability, be bound by those conditions.
(3) Where –
(a) An application has been filed by an agent duly appointed under
this rule on behalf of a person under disability; and
(b) That person, on ceasing to be a person under disability, elects himself
to proceed with the application –
that person shall be liable for all the costs of the proceedings in the same manner
as if he himself had commenced them after ceasing to be a person under disability.
(4) An application made by an agent on behalf of a person under disability
shall be attested and shall be made in the name of the agent, but the agent shall
state, in the application, that he is making it on behalf of the person under disability.

17 Guardian ad litem

(1) A Judge may (whether on application made to him ex parte, or of his
own motion, or otherwise) make an order appointing a guardian ad litem for any
person under disability whose interests are affected by any application not filed
by or on behalf of the person under disability.
(2) A guardian ad litem so appointed shall not be personally liable for costs
unless they are occasioned by his person negligence, dishonesty, or other
misconduct.
(3) No person shall be appointed a guardian ad litem without his written
consent.

18 Restrictions on persons under the age of 16 years and on persons of unsound mind

No person who is under the age of 16 years or of unsound mind shall, otherwise than with the leave of a Judge –
(a) Make any application to the Court or act as a party to any proceedings in the Court, otherwise than by and through an agent or guardian ad litem appointed pursuant to rule 16 or rule 17; or
(b) Act as an agent or representative in or with respect to any proceedings in the Court on behalf of any other person.
314 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

19 Registrar to give notice

(1) Subject to any directions of a Judge, the Registrar shall give in the Gazette
at least 14 clear days’ notice of the hearing of an application.
(2) The Registrar shall also give, in writing, at least 3 clear days’ notice of
the date of the commencement of the sitting of the Court at which an application
is intended to be heard to –
(a) The applicant; and
(b) Every person who has filed a notice of intention to appear; and
(c) Such other persons as the Registrar thinks fit; and
(d) Such other persons as a Judge may direct.
(3) All such notices shall be in a form and contain such particulars as a
Judge or the Registrar thinks necessary.

20 No notice required for ex parte applications

Notwithstanding any other provision of these Rules, an application which
may be made ex parte may, in his discretion, be heard and determined by a Judge,
without notification, at any time and place specified by a Judge.

21 Court may direct that notice be given

The Court may, before hearing or proceeding further with the hearing of
an application, require the Registrar or the applicant or any other party to the
proceedings to give such notice as the Court thinks necessary to any persons who
appear to the Court to be affected by the application.

22 Attendance of Clerk of the Court

(1) The Registrar shall arrange for the attendance, at every sitting of the
Court, of a Clerk of the Court.
(2) The Clerk of the Court shall, unless the Court otherwise directs, be a
skilled interpreter of the Niuean language into the English language and vice versa.
(3) The Registrar shall transmit all applications, to be heard at a sitting of
the Court, together with all other documents ancillary thereto and the necessary
Court records, to the Clerk of the Court, who shall be responsible for their custody
and safety and shall, as and when required, produce them to the Court.

23 Persons affected by applications

(1) Any person interested in or who may be affected by any application
shall be entitled to appear and be heard on the application.
(2) (a) Any person who is not named in an application and who wishes to
be a party to and be heard on the application shall, before the
commencement of the hearing of the application, file in the Court
office or in the Court a written notice in form 3 of his intention to
appear, stating whether he supports or opposes the application and
setting forth the grounds of any such support or opposition, and
specifying an address in Niue at which notices and other documents
relating to the application may be served on him, which address
shall, for the purposes of rule 7 (1) be deemed to be his last-known
place of business in Niue;
(b) No such person shall be debarred from appearing and being heard
on an application by reason only of his failure to file a notice of
intention to appear; but any person who has so failed shall be
allowed to appear and be heard on the application subject to such
reasonable and proper conditions as the Court thinks fit to impose.

Niue 315

(c) The Crown, the Minister, or the Registrar shall be entitled to appear and be heard on any application without filing or giving any notice of intention to appear.
(3) (a) Subject to rule 18 any person entitled to appear in any proceedings in the Court may appear either personally or, with the leave of the Court, by an agent or representative;
(b) Such leave may be given on such terms as the Court thinks fit, and may at any time be withdrawn.

24 Senior Judge to preside at sitting of Land Division

If more than one Judge is present at a sitting of the Court, the senior Judge
present shall preside.

25 Recording proceedings

The Judge or, if more than one Judge is present, one of the Judges nominated
by the presiding Judge, shall record the proceedings of the Court in a minute
book, which book shall be a record of the Court.

26 Powers of Court

(1) The Court may dismiss or grant any application, in whole or in part,
or, upon such terms as the Court thinks fit, give leave to extend, amend, or
withdraw an application, in whole or in part.
(2) The Court may dismiss an application on the grounds of the non­
appearance of the applicant or for want of proper prosecution, but any such
dismissal shall be without prejudice to the right of the applicant to make a fresh
application in respect of the same matter, or to the power of the Court to reinstate
an application so dismissed.
(3) Every order or decision made by the Court shall be recorded in the
minute book referred to in rule 25.

27 Evidence of witnesses

(1) Unless the Court otherwise directs, the evidence of witnesses at the
hearing of an application shall be given orally and upon oath or affirmation.
(2) The Court may accept evidence given by affidavit or declaration.
(3) Affidavits to be filed in the Court shall –
(a) If made in Niue, be made under section 78 (1) of the Act as if they
were affidavits in the High Court;
(b) If made outside Niue, be made under the same rules as are in force
for the time being with respect to affidavits in the High Court of
New Zealand.
(4) Declarations to be filed in the Court shall –
(a) If made in Niue, be made in accordance with section 720 of the Act;
(b) If made outside Niue, be made in accordance with the Oaths and
Declarations Act 1957 of New Zealand relating to declarations.
(5) The Court, in its discretion and on such terms as it thinks fit as to costs
or otherwise, may in any proceedings where it appears necessary make an order
for the examination on oath or affirmation before any officer of the Court or before
the Maori Land Court of New Zealand or a Judge thereof or before any other
person or persons, and at any place either in or out of New Zealand, of any witness
or other person, and may order any deposition so taken to be filed in the Court as
evidence in the proceedings.
316 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

28 Expenses of witnesses

A witness shall be allowed such reasonable expenses and allowances as
the Court thinks fit to award.

29 Summons to witness

(1) Any party to any proceedings shall be entitled to apply ex parte to a
Judge for an order that a summons to a witness be issued by the Court.
(2) A summons to a witness shall be in form 4, and may be addressed to
any number of persons not exceeding three.
(3) Every such summons shall be signed by a Judge or the Registrar and
shall be dated and shall be under the Seal of the Court.
(4) (a) Notwithstanding anything in these rules, service of any such
summons shall be personal.
(b) A Judge may direct that service of a summons (other than service
of a summons to show cause) in any particular case may be made
in such other manner as will, in his opinion, be sufficient to bring
the summons to the knowledge of the person to be served.
(5) Personal service of such a summons may be effected by leaving with
the witness a true copy of the summons, sealed with the Seal of the Court, and it
shall not be necessary to produce the original summons to the person served.
(6) Such a summons shall be served by –
(a) An officer of the Court; or
(b) A constable; or
(c) A person duly authorised in writing in that behalf by the person
who applied for the order under which the summons was issued;
or
(d) Such other person as a Judge or the Registrar specifies in writing.
(7) Unless the Judge otherwise directs in writing, there shall be paid or
tendered to a witness at the time of the service of a summons (other than a summons
to show cause) upon him, or at a reasonable time before the day on which he is
ordered to attend the Court, such reasonable sum of conduct money as is specified
in the summons by the Judge making the order granting the issue of the summons,
to enable the witness to go to, stay at, and return from the place of hearing.
(8) Service of a summons may be proved on affidavit or, at the hearing, on
oath.
(9) A summons to a witness to show cause shall be in form 5.
(10) Notwithstanding the foregoing provisions of this rule, a Judge may,
without application and of his own motion, direct that a summons to a witness shall be issued.

30 Application for rehearing

No application under section 45 of the Niue Amendment Act (No 2) 1968
for a rehearing shall be made after the expiration of 14 clear days after the making
of the order or determination in the matter in respect of which the rehearing is
sought.

31 Submission of drafts of orders

The Court or the Registrar may require any party in whose favour an order
has been made to submit a draft of the order to the Registrar.

Niue 317

32 Form of order

(1) An order shall be in form 6, unless the Court otherwise directs.
(2) The form of an order shall be finally settled by a Judge or the Registrar.
(3) Every order shall have annexed thereto such plans and other documents
as the Court may require.
(4) Every order shall be under the hand of a Judge or the Registrar and the
Seal of the Court.
(5) Duplicates of all orders shall be kept in and form part of the records of
the Court, and all duplicates of orders shall be marked “duplicate”.
(6) No order shall be issued out of the Court to the person entitled, other
than an order in favour of the Crown, the Minister, Cabinet or the Registrar until
all Court fees, other fees, duties, charges, and other money payable in respect
thereof have been duly paid.
(7) It shall be the duty of the Registrar, without any unnecessary delay, to
draw up and complete as far as possible all orders made by the Court.
(8) Nothing in these Rules shall restrict the power of the Court to make
interlocutory orders in respect of any matter as to which the Court is empowered
to make a final order.
(9) Where any order of the Court of Appeal makes provision for the
payment of any sum of money or for the imposition of any charge, then, for the
purposes of enforcing that provision or charge, the order shall be deemed to be an
order of the High Court.

33 Amendment of defects

(1) The Court shall have power in the course of any proceedings, and
whether with or without the application of any party, to amend all defects or
errors in the proceedings, whether there is anything in writing to amend or not,
and whether or not the defect or error is that of a party applying to amend.
(2) All such amendments may be made on such terms as the Court thinks
fit, and all amendments shall be made which are necessary for exercising as fully
and beneficially as possible the jurisdiction of the Court.

34 Amendment of records

(1) A Judge may at any time make or authorise to be made in any order,
warrant, record or other document made, issued, or kept by the Court all such
amendments as he considers necessary to give effect to the intended determination
or decision of the Court or to record the actual course and nature of any proceedings
in the Court.
(2) Any such amendment shall take effect as at the date of the order,
warrant, record, or other document amended, but no such amendment shall take
away or affect any right, title, or interest acquired in good faith and for value
before the making of the amendment.

35 Costs

In any proceedings the Court may make such order as it thinks fit for the
payment of the costs thereof, or of any matters incidental or preliminary thereto,
by or to any person who is a party to the proceedings, whether the parties by and
to whom all costs are so made payable are particles in the same or different interests.
318 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

36 Security for costs

(1) In any proceedings and at any stage the Court may require any party
to deposit with the Registrar or the Clerk of the Court or any other person specified
by the Court any sum of money as security for costs, and, in default of that deposit
being made, the Court may stay the proceedings, either wholly or in respect of the
party so in default.
(2) When any sum has been so deposited as security for costs, it shall be
disposed of in such manner as the Court directs.
(3) Notwithstanding any other provision of these Rules, neither the Crown,
nor the Minister, nor Cabinet, nor the Registrar shall in any case be liable to give
security for costs in respect of any application to or proceeding in the Court.

37 Charging orders for costs

(1) Where in any proceedings any order is made by the Court affecting or
relating to Niuean land, the Court may, in addition to or instead of making an
order under rule 35 make an order charging the whole or any part of those costs
on the rents, revenues, income, or profits arising or to arise from the land or upon
the share of any person in any such rents, revenues, income, or profits.
(2) Any such order shall be deemed to be a deed of assignment, valid and
effectual in all respects, enuring for the person in whose favour the order is made.

38 Powers and duties of Chief Justice in relation to notices of appeal

(1) (a) The Registrar, on receiving a notice of appeal, shall forthwith
transmit it, or a true copy thereof duly certified by the Registrar as
being such a copy, to the Chief Justice.
(b) On receipt thereof, the Chief Justice may, in his discretion and
without the necessity of hearing parties, if he is of the opinion that
the grounds of appeal are insufficiently stated in the notice, direct
that a more explicit statement of such grounds be lodged by the
appellant with the Registrar within a time to be fixed by the Chief
Justice, to be computed from and including the day on which notice
of the direction is given to the appellant.
(c) The Registrar shall forthwith give notice in writing of the direction
to the appellant accordingly.
(2) (a) On the receipt of a notice of appeal or a true copy thereof, the Chief
Justice shall, in his discretion and without hearing parties, decide
whether security for the costs of the appeal shall be given by the
appellant.
(b) If he decides that such security shall be given, he shall fix the amount
thereof and the time within which the security shall be given, that
time to be computed from and including the day on which notice
of the requirement of security is given to the appellant.
(c) The Registrar shall forthwith give notice in writing of the
requirement to the appellant accordingly.
(3) Security for the costs of an appeal shall in all cases be given by depositing
the amount in money with the Registrar, or any other person specified by the
Chief Justice.
(4) (a) Should the appellant fail to lodge a more explicit statement of
grounds of appeal or fail to give security for costs under this rule,
the Chief Justice may, on application by any person interested in
the appeal or of his own motion, make an order dismissing the
appeal or an order enlarging the time in which the appellant shall
lodge a more explicit statement of grounds of appeal or give security
for costs.

Niue 319

(b) The Registrar shall give notice in writing of any such order to the appellant accordingly.
(5) (a) If, within the time enlarged as aforesaid, the appellant fails to lodge a more explicit statement of grounds of appeal or fails to give security for costs paragraph (4) shall apply;
(b) Should an appellant not lodge a more explicit statement of the
grounds of appeal or give security for costs within a period of 2
years computed from and including the date on which he was first
given notice in that regard by the Registrar, the appeal shall be
deemed to have been heard and finally dismissed by the Court.

39 Appeal from Commissioner

(1) Any party to any proceedings before a Commissioner may appeal from
any order or decision of the Commissioner to a Judge of the High Court.
(2) Every such appeal shall be by way of an application in form 1 to the
High Court, and shall be filed in the Court office within 28 clear days after the
date of the order or decision appealed from.
(3) On the filing of such an appeal, the Commissioner shall, unless a Judge
otherwise orders, stay further proceedings on the order or decision appealed from.
(4) Every such appeal shall be by way of rehearing.
(5) Before hearing an appeal, a Judge may impose such conditions on the
appellant as the Judge thinks fit as to security for costs or otherwise.
(6) If the appellant fails to prosecute the appeal with due diligence, or fails
to observe or perform any of the conditions imposed on him under paragraph (5),
the Judge may dismiss the appeal.
(7) (a) The appellant may, at any time before the hearing of the appeal,
discontinue his appeal, either wholly or in part, by filing in the
Court a notice of discontinuance.
(b) If an appeal is wholly discontinued, the order or decision may be
immediately carried into effect and the appeal shall be deemed to
have been dismissed under paragraph (6) and the Court shall give
directions as to the disposal of any sum deposited as security for
costs.
(8) A Commissioner may at any stage of any proceedings before him
adjourn the proceedings for hearing and determination by a Judge.
(9) No appeal from an order or decision of a Commissioner shall, save
with the leave of the Court or the Court of Appeal, be brought in the Court of
Appeal.

40 Withdrawal of appeal

(1) Without limiting rule 39, an appellant may before the hearing of his
appeal by notice in writing given to the Registrar, or at any time after the hearing
has begun by oral application made in open Court, apply to the Court for leave to
withdraw his appeal.
(2) Leave to withdraw an appeal may be given on such terms as the Court
thinks fit to impose, and the Court shall, in granting such leave, give directions as
to the disposal of any sum deposited as security for costs.
(3) Any appeal so withdrawn shall be deemed to have been finally
dismissed by the Court.
(4) This rule shall apply to –
(a) Any appeal from an order or decision of a Commissioner;
(b) Any appeal to the Court of Appeal.
320 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

41 Appeals to be by way of rehearing

(1) All appeals to the Court of Appeal shall be by way of rehearing.
(2) (a) On the hearing of any appeal the parties shall be restricted to the
evidence adduced at the hearing upon which the order or decision
appealed from was made.
(b) The Court of Appeal may allow such further evidence to be adduced
as may in its opinion be necessary to enable it to come to a just
decision upon the matters in issue.
(c) The Court of Appeal may refer to any record or other document
filed or held in the records of the Court although the same may not
have been produced or referred to at the hearing in the High Court.
(3) The evidence adduced at the hearing upon which the order or decision
appealed from was made shall be proved by the records of the High Court, and
no other proof thereof, except by leave of the Court of Appeal shall be admitted.

42 Court of Appeal

(1) On the hearing of an appeal to the Court of Appeal no person other
than the appellant shall, except with the leave of the Court, be heard in support of
the appeal or put forward any claim contrary to the order or decision appealed
from, and no other person shall be heard save a person who satisfies the Court
that he is a person interested in the proceedings.
(2) No appeal shall be allowed on any ground not set out in the notice of
appeal, or in a more explicit statement of the grounds of appeal, or in an amended
statement of the grounds of appeal, unless the Court is of the opinion that the
appeal may be so allowed without injustice to all other parties interested in the
appeal.

43 Exemptions from payment of fees

(1) No fee shall be payable on any application by the Crown, the Minister,
Cabinet, or the Registrar.
(2) No fee shall be payable on the filing of a notice of intention to appear
referred to in rule 23.

44 Scale of fees

(1) Subject to rule 43, there shall be paid in respect of the matters described
in Schedule 2 the fees set out there.
(2) Subject to rule 45, no document shall be filed in the Court without the
leave of a Judge or the Registrar unless the prescribed fee has been paid.

45 Reduction and remission of fees

The Court or a Judge may reduce or remit any fee.

46 Certified and sealed copies

Unless otherwise directed by a Judge, the Registrar, upon payment of the
fee prescribed in Schedule 2, shall furnish to any person applying for the same a
certified or sealed copy of any order or document made by or filed or lodged in
the Court.

47 Arrangement of business

The Court may arrange the order of its business as it thinks fit.

Niue 321

48 Matters not provided for

In any matter for which no provision is made by these Rules, the Court
may proceed as it thinks fit, and shall dispose of the matter as nearly as may be in accordance with any rules affecting any similar case or, if there be no such rules, in such manner as the Court thinks best calculated to promote the ends of justice.

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULES

Rule 12 (1)

SCHEDULE 1

FORM 1

(EX PARTE) APPLICATION TO THE HIGH COURT

Number

IN THE HIGH COURT OF NIUE

I,

HEREBY APPLY for an ORDER UPON THE GROUNDS:

IN THE MATTER OF

of

Dated this day of 20

This application is made in reliance upon

Applicant (Agent for Application). Witness (where rule 16(4) applies)

Fee: $ This application was filed by

And notices and other documents relating to this application may be served on the applicant at

For Court use only. Initials

1. Date of filing of application:

2. Date fee paid:

3. Notes:

Rule 12 (4)

FORM 2

NOTICE OF APPEAL

Number IN THE COURT OF APPEAL

OF NIUE

IN THE MATTER OF I,

of

GIVE NOTICE that I hereby APPEAL from the order or decision of the High Court, which order or decision is set out in the Schedule herein enforced or hereto annexed, UPON THE GROUNDS:

AND upon those grounds, I HEREBY APPLY to the Court of Appeal for an ORDER Dated this day of 20

This notice of appeal is given in reliance upon

322 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULE

Fee: $15.00

Witness:

This notice of appeal was filed by

Appellant (Agent for Appellant)

And notices and other documents relating to this appeal may be served on the appellant at

For Court use only. Initials

1. Date of filing of notice of appeal:

2. Date fee paid:

3. Notes:

Rule 23 (2)

FORM 3

NOTICE OF INTENTION TO APPEAR

Number IN THE COURT OF APPEAL

OF NIUE

IN THE MATTER of Rule 23 of the Land

Rules 1969

AND

IN THE MATTER of an application (appean( �/p>

by

for

I,

of

claiming to be interested in or affected by the above-mentioned application (appeal) HEREBY GIVE NOTICE that I intend to appear in support of (opposition to) the same UPON THE GROUNDS:

Dated this day of 20

Claimant.

Address for service:

No fee.

For Court use only. Initials

1. Date of filing of notice:

2. Notes:

Niue 323

Rule 29 (2)

FORM 4

SUMMONS TO WITNESS

Number IN THE COURT OF APPEAL

OF NIUE

IN THE MATTER of Rule 29 of the Land Rules

1969

To:

AND

IN THE MATTER of an application (appeal) by

for

of

YOU ARE HEREBY SUMMONED to attend the Court at on the of 20 at the hour of o’clock in the noon, and from day to day until required, to give evidence in the above matter and YOU ARE HEREBY REQUIRED then and there to have and produce to the Court all the documents mentioned in the Schedule hereto, and all other documents of whatsoever nature relating to that matter in your possession, custody, or control. Should you fail to obey this summons, you will be liable, for that failure, to such punishment or penalty as is by law provided, if there was paid or tendered to you, in accordance with the abovementioned role, conduct money in the sum of $

THIS SUMMONS was issued at the request of

AS WITNESS the hand of the Judge (Registrar) (Deputy Registrar) and the Seal of the

Court this day of 20

SCHEDULE

Judge (Registrar) (Deputy Registrar)

I, a Judge of the above-mentioned

Court hereby direct, pursuant to rule 29(4) of the Rules of the Court, that service of this

summons may be effected in the following manner, namely, by

make oath and say that I served the above-named with a summons, of which the copy of the summons upon which this affidavit is endorsed is a true copy, by delivering it to him (her) personally at

on the day of

20

at o’clock in the noon and that at the same

time I paid (tendered) to him (her) the amount of the conduct money specified in the

summons.

SWORN by the above-mentioned

at

this day of

20 before me:

324 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Rule 29 (5)

FORM 5

SUMMONS TO WITNESS TO SHOW CAUSE

IN THE COURT OF APPEAL OF NIUE

IN THE MATTER of Rule 29 of the Land

Rules 1969

To:

AND

IN THE MATTER of an application

by

for

of

YOU ARE HEREBY SUMMONED to attend the Court at on the day of 20 at o’clock in the noon, to SHOW CAUSE why you should not be dealt with according to law for your failure to observe the provisions of a summons dated the day of 20

Issued in the matter of the above-mentioned application and duly served upon you: AND TAKE NOTICE that if you fail to observe this summons the matter may be determined in your absence.

AS WITNESS the hand of the Judge (Registrar) (Deputy Registrar) and the Seal of the

make oath and say that I served the above-named

with a summons, of which the copy of

the summons upon which this affidavit is endorsed is a true copy by delivering the same

to him (her) personally at on

the day of 20 at o’clock in the

noon

SWORN by the above-mentioned

at

this day of

20 before me:

Niue 325

Rule 32 (1) Number

IN THE COURT OF APPEAL

OF NIUE

FORM 6

ORDER

IN THE MATTER of

At a sitting of the Court held on the day of 20 , Before Esquire(s), Chief Judge, Judge(s)

(Commissioner)

UPON HEARING the application (appeal) of dated the day of 20 in the matter of IT IS HEREBY ORDERED, pursuant to the provisions of

THAT

AS WITNESS the hand of the Chief Judge (Judge) (Commissioner) (Registrar) (Deputy

Registrar) and the Seal of the Court.

Court of Appeal

Minute Book References

Chief Judge (Judge) (Commissioner) (Registrar) (Deputy Registrar)

Volume(s) Folio(s)

––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE 2

FEES

$

1

On filing of application to the High Court which may be made ex parte

10.00

2

On filing an application to a Judge of the High Court by way of appeal from

a decision of a Commissioner

35.00

3

On filing of any other application to the High Court

(1) Determination of Title

10.00

(2) Leveki Mangafaoa

5.00

4

On filing a notice of appeal to the Court of Appeal

55.00

5

On filing of any application not mentioned before in this Schedule

10.00

6

On furnishing a certified or sealed copy under rule 46

(1) Of any application or order

10.00

(2) Of any other document

10.00

7

For registering any instrument

10.00

8

For entry of any memorial of registration

5.00

9

For any power of attorney deposited

15.00

10

For revocation of any power of attorney

15.00

11

For registering any caveat

15.00

12

For cancellation or withdrawal of caveat for any notice to any caveat

10.00

13

For any instrument deposited for safe custody

20.00

14

For registering or noting anything not otherwise provided

20.00

15

For every single search

2.00

16

For every general search

5.00

326 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

17

Certified copies

(1)

Of any instrument or extract from Register

10.00

(2)

Of any page or part thereof supplied by photocopy or any processed

reproduction

(1)

A4

1.00

(2)

Foolscap

2.00

18

Provisional and final plans

Prov A3

5.00

Final A2

10.00

19

Survey charge deposit – for redefining boundaries of titled land,

missing posts, etc.

30.00

20

Registration of incorporated societies

30.00

Niue 327

LAND REGISTRATION REGULATIONS 1969

1969 – 1 November 1969

1. Title

2. Interpretation

PART 1

ADMINISTRATION

3 Duties of Registrar

4 Land Registry

5 Land Register

6 Journal and index to be kept

7 Instruments

8 Correction of errors in Land Register

PART 2

REGISTRATION

9 Presentation of instruments for registration

10 Registrar may refuse to register any

instrument

11 Registration as to part of land affected

12 Alterations or erasures in instruments

13 Instrument not to be altered

14 Instruments executed by an attorney or

representative

15 Procedure for registration of instruments

16 Priority according to time of presentation

for registration

17 Instruments to be in duplicate

18 Memorial to be recorded on duplicate

instrument

19 Registrar may dispense with production of

duplicate instruments

29 Receipt may be given for instruments

presented for registration or deposit

21 Persons having an estate or interest in land

may be required to register any instruments

1 Title

These are the Land Registration Regulations 1969.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Niue Act 1966;
“dealing” means every transfer, transmission, charge, lease, encumbrance,
or other alienation or transaction affecting any land or interest in any
land under these Regulations;
“endorsement” in addition to its ordinary meaning, includes anything
written on or at the foot of any document for giving effect to any of the
purposes of these Regulations;
328 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
“instrument” means any printed or written document, map, plan or other dealing affecting any land or interest in any land;
“register” means enter in the Land Register under these Regulations; “Registrar” means the Registrar of the High Court, and includes a Deputy
Registrar.
(2) A reference to a numbered form is a reference to a form so numbered in
Schedule 1.
(3) Expressions defined in this Act have the meanings so defined.

3 Duties of Registrar

PART 1
ADMINISTRATION
The Registrar shall be responsible for the work to be carried out in the
Land Registry.

4 Land Registry

There shall be a Land Registry established in the High Court Office, which
shall be open daily for public business from 10am to 3pm except on Saturdays
and public holidays.

5 Land Register

(1) The Registrar shall keep books comprising and to be called the Land
Register.
(2) The number of parcels or subdivisions of land which may be included
in one folium of the Land Register shall be at the absolute discretion of the Registrar.
(3) The Registrar shall record on each folium the particulars of all
instruments, dealings, and other matters by these Regulations required to be
registered or entered on the Land Register.

6 Journal and index to be kept

In addition to the Land Register provided for by regulation 5, the Registrar
shall keep the following –
(a) A journal, in which shall be entered particulars of all instruments
received for registration, referring to them by number in the order
in which they are so received for registration, the volume and folio
of the Land Register against which such instrument is to be
registered and such other particulars and references as he thinks
fit;
(b) An alphabetical index, in which shall be entered appropriate
references to every power of attorney or other instrument deposited
in the Land Registry.

7 Instruments

(1) All instruments for registration or entry on the Land Register must be
legibly and clearly written, typewritten or printed on sheets of paper of foolscap
size of good quality. Carbon copies of instruments shall not be filed. A margin of
not less than one-eighth of the width of the paper shall be on the left side.
(2) The Registrar may waive the requirements of this regulation in whole
or in part.

Niue 329

8 Correction of errors in Land Register

(1) Where a mistake has been made in the Land Register, the Registrar
shall rectify the mistake by a new entry in such form as may be convenient,
specifying the day and hour of each correction, and initialling the correction.
(2) The erroneous entry shall in no case be erased or obliterated.
PART 2
REGISTRATION

9 Presentation of instruments for registration

(1) Every instrument presented for registration shall have endorsed
thereon –
(a) The names of the parties; and
(b) The nature of the instrument; and
(c) A reference to the appropriate volume and folio of the Land Register;
and
(d) Such other particulars as the Registrar may consider necessary.
(2) No registration of any instrument shall be invalidated by non­
compliance with this regulation.

10 Registrar may refuse to register any instrument

The Registrar may refuse to register any instrument on the grounds –
(a) That it is invalid according to law; or
(b) That it is subject to any material defect, error or omission; or
(c) That it is not made subject to any existing registered encumbrance,
estate, or interest; or
(d) That for any other reason it is incapable of complete registration.

11 Registration as to part of land affected

(1) Notwithstanding anything in regulation 10, an instrument may be
accepted for registration as to part only of the land affected if a request for such
partial registration is endorsed thereon and signed by the person presenting the
instrument for registration.
(2) A partially registered instrument may, at the like request and on
payment of the requisite fees, be re-registered as to the remainder or any other
part of the land affected thereby.

12 Alterations or erasures in instruments

(1) The Registrar may refuse to register any instrument containing an
erasure or alteration.
(2) Mistakes should be corrected by deleting the words or figures written
in error and writing the correct words or figures above them.
(3) Where any correction, interlineation, or addition affects or could affect
the interests of the persons executing the instrument, it should be initialled by
those persons and by the attesting witnesses. Where it affects or could affect the
interests of the persons receiving the benefit under the transaction, it should be
initialled by those persons.

13 Instrument not to be altered

(1) Except where authorised by the Registrar or a Judge of the High Court,
no alteration whatever shall be allowed to be made to any application or instrument
during retention thereof in the Land Registry.
(2) No alteration whatever may be made in any instrument after it has
been registered.
330 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

14 Instruments executed by an attorney or representative

(1) Any instrument executed by one person on behalf of another as his
attorney or authorised representative shall be accompanied by a statutory
declaration to the effect that he has not received any notice or information of the
revocation of his power of attorney or certificate of representation by death or
otherwise.
(2) That statutory declaration shall be made immediately before or
immediately after the execution of the instrument.
(3) No such declaration shall be necessary in the case of a legally irrevocable
power of attorney, unless the power is irrevocable for a fixed time therein specified
and that time has expired at the date of execution of this instrument.

15 Procedure for registration of instruments

(1) Upon the acceptance of any instrument for registration, the Registrar
shall number the instrument and make a note thereon of the day and hour of the
receipt, and enter the same in the journal.
(2) The Registrar shall thereupon cause a memorial thereof to be entered
in the appropriate volume and folio of the Land Register. The memorial shall
state –
(a) The number and nature of the instrument; and
(b) The name of each person taking any benefit under the instrument;
and
(c) The date and hour of the production of the instrument for
registration; and
(d) Such other particulars as the Registrar considers expedient.
(3) Every memorial shall be signed by the Registrar.
(4) The original instrument shall, wherever possible, be filed and retained
in the Land Registry.

16 Priority according to time of presentation for registration

Every instrument shall be registered in the order of time in which it is
presented for registration.

17 Instruments to be in duplicate

Every instrument presented for registration shall (except in the case of an
order of the High Court or the Court of Appeal) be in duplicate.

18 Memorial to be recorded on duplicate instrument

(1) Whenever a memorial of any instrument has been entered in the Land
Register, the Registrar shall record the like memorial on the duplicate lease or
other instrument evidencing title to the estate or interest intended to be dealt with
or in any way affected, unless the Registrar, as hereinafter provided, dispenses
with the production of that duplicate.
(2) The Registrar shall endorse on every instrument so registered a
certificate of the date and hour on which the said memorial was entered in the
Land Register, and shall authenticate each such certificate by signing his name
and affixing his seal thereto.
(3) Every such certificate shall be received in all courts as conclusive
evidence that the instrument has been duly registered.

Niue 331

19 Registrar may dispense with production of duplicate instruments

(1) The Registrar may dispense with the production of any duplicate of
any instrument.
(2) (a) Where production has been dispensed with as aforesaid, then, upon
the registration of any dealing, the Registrar shall notify in the
memorial in the Land Register that no entry of that memorial has
been made on the duplicate instrument, and every other dealing
shall thereupon be as valid and effectual as if the memorial had
been so entered.
(b) Before registering any such dealing the Registrar shall give at least
28 clear days’ notice in the Gazette of his intention to register the
dealing.

20 Receipt may be given for instruments presented for registration or deposit Every person by whom any instrument is brought or sent to the Land Registry for the purpose of registration or deposit may require a receipt for the instrument, which receipt shall be signed by the Registrar or some officer of the Land Registry duly authorised in writing in that behalf by the Registrar, and shall specify the nature and number of the instrument and the day and hour when it

was received by the Registrar.

21 Persons having an estate or interest in land may be required to register any instruments

Any person having an estate or interest in land through any instrument authorised to be registered by these Regulations or any other enactment may require any person having possession of that instrument to cause it to be registered. If he fails or refuses to do so, any Judge of the High Court may, on application to him, make such order respecting the registration of the instrument and the costs thereof as he thinks fit.

22 Certified copies of instruments to be evidence

The Registrar, upon payment of the prescribed fee, shall furnish to any
person applying for the same a certified copy of any registered instrument affecting
land, and every such certified copy signed by him and sealed with his seal, shall
be received in evidence for all purposes for which the original instrument might
be put in evidence.
PART 3
POWER OF ATTORNEY

23 Power of attorney may be deposited with Registrar

(1) The proprietor of any land or any person claiming any estate or interest
in any land may, by power of attorney in form 1, and either in general terms or
specially, authorise and appoint any person on his behalf to execute instruments
therewith, or to make an application to the Registrar or to a Judge of the High
Court in relation thereto.
(2) Every power of attorney intended to be used under these Regulations,
or a duplicate or attested copy thereof, verified to the satisfaction of the Registrar,
shall be deposited with the Registrar.
(3) Any power of attorney made or used under these Regulations shall
not be invalidated by reason of the power not having been created under seal.
(4) No memorial shall be made in the Land Register in respect of any power
of attorney deposited in the Land Registry.
332 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

24 Revocation of power of attorney

(1) The donor of any revocable power of attorney may, by notice to the
Registrar in form 2, revoke the power of attorney, either wholly or as to the land
specified in the notice.
(2) No power of attorney shall be deemed to have been revoked by reason
only of a subsequent power of attorney being deposited without express notice as
aforesaid, nor shall any such revocation take effect as to instruments executed
before the reception of the notice by the Registrar.
(3) No power of attorney shall be deemed to have been or to be revoked
by the bankruptcy or insolvency of the grantee or by the marriage of a female
grantee.
(4) When any instrument of revocation is deposited, the Registrar shall
thereupon note on the power of attorney a minute of the revocation and record
the same in the alphabetical index.

25 Searches

PART 4
SEARCHES
(1) On payment of the prescribed fees any person may search the Land Register, the journal, the alphabetical index, and all registered and deposited instruments and plans at any time when the Land Registry is open for public business.
(2) (a) For the purpose of assessing such fees, every search shall be deemed to be completed on the day on which it is commenced.
(b) The Registrar may allow a search not completed on one day to be completed on the following or a subsequent day without further fee.

26 Single search

A single search shall be deemed to include –
(a) The inspection of any one folium of the Land Register and of all
registered instruments and plans referred to therein.
(b) The inspection of any one registered or deposited instrument or
plan without reference to any particular folium of the Land Register.

27 General search

A general search shall be deemed to include inspection of any number of
folios of the Land Register in the name of one proprietor with the relative
instruments and plans.

28 Assistance to persons searching

Reasonable assistance may be afforded by the Registrar and his staff to any
person searching, but no search may be made by the Registrar or his staff except
by special arrangement previously approved by Cabinet and no responsibility
shall be incurred by the Registrar or his staff for the accuracy of any information
obtained by any such search.

Niue 333

PART 5
CAVEATS

29 Caveats to be signed by caveator, attorney, or authorised representative

(1) Every caveat shall be signed by the caveator or by his attorney or duly
authorised representative, and shall state with sufficient certainty the nature of
the right, title, estate, or interest claimed by the caveator, and shall appoint a place
or give an address in Niue at which notices and proceedings relating to the caveat
may be served or addressed.
(2) Every caveat shall be entered on the appropriate folium of the Land
Register as of the day and hour of the reception thereof by the Registrar.
(3) A caveat shall be in form 3 or form 4, as the case may require.
(4) The Registrar may enter a caveat –
(a) To protect the rights of any person beneficially interested under
any trust, the existence of which trust is known to the Registrar; or
(b) To protect the rights of any person where consent is required to
any dealing with land, the existence of which rights is known to
the Registrar; or
(c) To protect the rights of any person who is an infant, or of unsound
mind, or who is absent from Niue; or
(d) To protect the rights of the Crown; or
(e) To prevent any fraudulent or improper dealing.
(5) So long as a caveat remains in force, the Registrar shall not register any
instrument presented for registration after the lodging of the caveat and affecting
the estate or interest (at law or in equity) protected by the caveat.
(6) Upon the receipt of any caveat, the Registrar shall (if possible) notify in
writing the existence of the caveat to the proprietor against whose estate or interest
the caveat has been lodged.
(7) (a) Any such proprietor may make an application to the High Court
for an order that the caveat be removed.
(b) The High Court shall not make any such order unless it is satisfied
that under the rules of the Court, the caveator or his attorney or
duly authorised representative has been served with a copy of the
application.
(8) On the hearing of any such application, the proprietor shall be entitled
to such an order unless the caveator establishes to the satisfaction of the Court,
that the caveat should not be removed.
(9) On making any such order, the Court may direct that the caveat be
wholly or partly removed, or removed only for certain purposes, and either
unconditionally or subject to such conditions as the Court considers proper.

30 Caveator may except certain instruments

A caveator may except from the operation of a caveat any instrument or
class of instruments, and such a caveat shall not prevent the registration of any
instrument or class of instruments so specifically excepted.

31 Service of notice as to caveats

Every notice relating to a caveat and any proceedings in respect thereof, if
served at the place appointed in the caveat or forwarded through the Post Office
by registered letter addressed as aforesaid, shall be deemed duly served.
334 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

32 Person lodging caveat without due cause liable for damages

(1) Any person lodging any caveat without reasonable cause is liable to
make to any person who may have sustained damage thereby such compensation
as may be just.
(2) Such compensation shall be recoverable in an action in the Court by
the person who has sustained damage from the person who lodged the caveat.
(3) This regulation shall not apply to a caveat lodged by the Registrar.

33 Caveat may be withdrawn

Any caveat may be withdrawn by the caveator or by his attorney or duly
authorised representative under a written authority, and either as to the whole or
any part of the land affected, or the consent of the caveator or of his attorney or
authorised representative may be given for the registration of any particular dealing
expressed to be made subject to the rights of the caveator.

34 Mergers

PART 6
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
(1) The Registrar, upon being satisfied that any estate or interest shown on the Land Register has merged according to the rules of law and equity with any other estate or interest, may, upon the written application of the person in whom those estates or interests are shown on the Land Register as being vested, or of his duly authorised attorney, solicitor or agent make such entries in the Land Register as may be necessary to give effect to the merger.
(2) The same fees shall be payable as for the registration of an instrument.

35 Registrar to have and use seal of office

The Registrar shall have and use a seal of office, which shall be in such
form as Cabinet approves, and every imprint of such a seal and purporting to be
signed or issued by the Registrar, or by his deputy, shall be received in evidence,
and shall be deemed to be signed or issued by or under the direction of the Registrar,
without further proof, unless the contrary is shown.

36 Forms

(1) The forms prescribed by these Regulations for use in the Land Registry
are set out in Schedule 1 and indicated by the corresponding numbers therein.
(2) The forms may be used with such modifications as may be required,
and, if no form is prescribed by these Regulations, then such form may be used as
Cabinet may direct or approve.

37 Fees

(1) The fees set out in Schedule 2 are hereby prescribed as the fees to be
paid for the registration or deposit of any instrument and any search under these
Regulations.
(2) No fee shall be payable in respect of the following transactions –
(a) The bringing of land and any relevant documents relating to the
registration of the first title to land under these Regulations; or
(b) The filing or registration of any instrument or any search on behalf
of the Crown or by the Registrar.
(3) Subject to paragraph (2), no instrument shall, without the leave of the
Registrar, be registered or deposited, unless the prescribed fee has been paid.
––––––––––––––––––––

Niue 335

SCHEDULES

SCHEDULE 1

Form 1

POWER OF ATTORNEY

Reg. 23 (1)

I, A.B. of [Address and occupation], being the proprietor of an estate [Here state nature of the estate or interest] subject, however, to such encumbrances, liens, and interests as are notified by memorandum underwritten or endorsed hereon, in [Here refer to Schedule for description and contents of the several parcels of land intended to be affected, which Schedule must contain reference to the existing volume and folio of the Land Register], hereby appoint C.D., of [Address and occupation], attorney on my behalf to [Here state the nature and extent of the powers intended to be conferred, as whether to sell, lease, mortgage] the lands in the said Schedule described, and to execute all such instruments and do all such acts, matters and things as may be necessary for carrying out the powers hereby given, and for the recovery of all rents and sums of money that may become or are now due or owing to me in respect of the said lands, and for the enforcement of all contracts, covenants, or conditions binding upon any lessee or occupier of the said lands or upon any other person in respect of the same, and for the taking and maintaining possession of the said lands, and for protecting

I, A.B. of [Address and occupation], being the proprietor of an estate [Here state the nature of the estate] in all that piece of land [Here describe the land, referring to the volume and folio of the Land Register], hereby revoke the power of attorney given by me to C.D., of [Address and occupation], dated the

day of 20 .

In witness whereof I have hereunto subscribed my name this

day of 20 .

Signed by the above-named A.B, in the presence of –

A.B.

G.H.

[Occupation and address]

336 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Form 3 Reg. 29 (3) CAVEAT FORBIDDING REGISTRATION OF DEALING

To the Registrar of the High Court, Niue

Take notice that I, A.B. of [Occupation and address], claiming estate or interest [Here state

the nature of the estate or interest claimed, and the ground on which claim is founded] in [Here

describe land], forbid the registration of any instrument affecting the said estate or interest

until this caveat is withdrawn by me, or by order of the High Court.

And I appoint [Here state an address in Niue] as the place at which notices relating

hereto may be served,

Dated this day of 20 .

Signed by the above-named [Name of caveator], as caveator, in the presence of – C.D.

[Occupation and address]

A.B.

Form 4 Reg. 29 (3) CAVEAT BY REGISTRAR FORBIDDING REGISTRATION OF DEALING

Take notice that the Registrar hereby forbids the registration of any instrument affecting the estate or interest described in Schedule 1, upon the grounds set out in Schedule 2 until this caveat is withdrawn by him, or by order of the High Court or a Judge thereof, or by order of the Court of Appeal.

As witness the hand of the Registrar (Deputy Registrar) and the seal of office of the

Registrar this day of 20 .

Signed by the Registrar
(Deputy Registrar) and

SCHEDULE 2

sealed with the Registrar ’s ................................................................ seal of office in the presence Registrar (Deputy Registrar)
of:
Witness: Occupation: Address:
Notices relating hereto must be addressed to the Registrar at the Land Registry in
Niue.

FEES Reg. 37

$

1 For registering an instrument ................................................................................... 1.00

2. For every entry of a memorial of registration ........................................................ 0.20

3, For every power of attorney deposited ................................................................... 1.00

4. For depositing every revocation of a power of attorney ...................................... 1.00

5. For registering any caveat ......................................................................................... 1.00

6. For cancelling or withdrawal of caveat and for every

notice relating to any caveat ..................................................................................... 0.50

7. For any instrument deposited for safe custody ..................................................... 1.00

8. For registering or noting anything not otherwise provided for .......................... 1.00

9. For every single search .............................................................................................. 0.20

10. For every general search ............................................................................................ 0.50

11. Certified copies –

(a) Of any instrument or extract from the Land Register –

for every 100 words or part thereof ................................................................. 0.05

(b) Of any page or part thereof supplied by photocopy or

other reproduction processes ........................................................................... 0.20

Niue 337

MARRIAGE REGULATIONS 1970

These are the Marriage Regulations 1970.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Niue Act 1966;
“marriage officer” means a marriage officer as defined in section 516 of the
Act;
“Register” means the Marriage Register kept under regulation 6;
“Registrar” means the Registrar of the High Court, and includes the Deputy
Registrar.
(2) Other expressions defined in the Act have the meanings so defined.
(3) A reference to a numbered form is a reference to a form so numbered in
Schedule 1.

3 Solemnisation of marriage

(1) All marriages must be solemnised between the hours of 8am and 5pm.
(2) At the time of solemnisation of a marriage, the doors of the building (if
any) shall be kept open to allow of the admission of the public.
(3) The 2 witnesses to a marriage shall be of or over the age of 21 years.

4 Notice of marriage

The notice of marriage required under section 520 of the Act shall be in
form 1.

5 Consent to marriage of minors

The consent required under section 526 of the Act shall be in form 2.

6 Marriage Registers

Every marriage officer shall keep for the purpose of recording marriages a
Marriage Register in form 3 supplied for the purpose by the Registrar.

7 Record of marriage

(1) Every marriage officer by whom a marriage is solemnised shall
forthwith record on the original and copies of the Register the several particulars
relating to the marriage required by form 3.
338 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(2) If a marriage officer is called upon to solemnise a marriage and at the time no Register is available, he shall enter the particulars of the marriage on a blank form instead of in the Register, and shall, as soon as practicable, affix the form in the Register and that form shall be deemed part of the Register.
(3) No marriage shall be invalidated by any error or defect in form 3 or in the particulars so required to be recorded.

8 Transmission of record to Registrar

The duplicate copy of the Register shall be transmitted to the Registrar
under section 524 of the Act.

9 Marriage certificate

Every marriage officer by whom any marriage is solemnised shall, without
fee, deliver to one of the parties to the marriage a marriage certificate in form 3.

10 Custody of Registers

(1) The Registers shall be safely kept by the marriage officers in whose
custody they are placed, and shall be deemed to be the property of the Crown.
(2) Upon the death, dismissal, transfer, or resignation of any marriage
officer, the custody of those Registers shall pass to his successor in office.

11 Registers open to public

The Registers to be kept under these Regulations shall at all reasonable
times be open to the public on payment of the prescribed fee.

12 Registrar may issue certified copies or certificates of any entry

(1) The Registrar shall, on the application of any person, and on payment
of the appropriate fee prescribed in Schedule 2, issue in form 4 certified copies or
certificates of any entry made in the Registers.
(2) Notwithstanding this regulation, the Registrar may dispense with the
payment of any fee payable under these Regulations in cases of genuine hardship.

13 Issue of certified copies of entries for official purposes

Notwithstanding regulation 12, where a certified copy of any entry in a
Register kept under these Regulations or a certificate as to any such entry is required
for any official purpose, the Registrar shall issue the certified copy or special
certificate in the prescribed form, free of any charge.

14 Certified copy of any entry in Registers to be received in Court

A certified copy of any entry in a Register, made or given and purporting
to be signed by the Registrar and stamped with his seal, or made or purporting to
be signed by any Deputy Registrar and stamped with the seal of the Registrar,
shall be received in any court as prima facie evidence of the marriage to which it
relates.

15 Correction of errors

(1) Any clerical error or any error of fact or substance or any omission of
any material fact in any Register may be corrected by the Registrar.
(2) For the purpose of this regulation, the Registrar may require to be
produced a statutory declaration and such other evidence as to the facts as he
considers necessary.

Niue 339

(3) Any person having custody of a Register shall, upon the direction of the Registrar, make corrections of any errors or omissions in the Register.
(4) Except as provided in this regulation, no alteration shall be made in any entry in any Register after the entry has been completed.

16 Discretion of Registrar

Where for any sufficient cause shown to the satisfaction of the Registrar
any act, matter, or thing required by these Regulations cannot be done within the
time limited by or in strict compliance with the conditions imposed by these
Regulations, it shall be sufficient if that act, matter, or thing is done within a
reasonable time thereafter, or if the conditions imposed are complied with so far
as is reasonably possible.

17 Endorsement of marriage entry where marriage dissolved

(1) Upon the making of a decree of divorce, or a decree of presumption of
death and of dissolution of marriage, or a decree of nullity of marriage, or a decree
of dissolution of a voidable marriage in respect of any marriage solemnised in
Niue, the Registrar shall cause a memorandum to be entered on the record of the
marriage entry.
(2) The Registrar shall forward a notice of the memorandum referred to in
paragraph (1) to the marriage officer (if any) having lawful custody of the Marriage
Register in which the marriage is registered, and the marriage officer shall enter
the particulars disclosed in the notice on the entry in the Marriage Register.
(3) Every certified copy of an entry in a Marriage Register issued after any
memorandum has been entered as provided by this regulation shall contain the
particulars disclosed in the memorandum.

18 Fees

(1) There shall be paid to the Registrar for various matters specified in
Schedule 2 the respective fees specified in that Schedule.
(2) Every marriage officer is hereby empowered to receive and take on
behalf of the Registrar the several fees specified in Schedule 2.
––––––––––––––––––––
340 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULES SCHEDULE 1

Reg. 4 FORM 1

Niue

NOTICE OF INTENDED MARRIAGE

To , a marriage officer of Niue.

Notice is hereby given that the undermentioned parties intend to marry at

[Church or other place where marriage is to be solemnised] on 20

Bridegroom

Bride

Name and surname

Age

Occupation

Status (i.e. bachelor, spinster, widower, widow, or divorced)

Birthplace

Usual residence

Father ’s name and surname

Father ’s occupation

Mother ’s name and surname

I solemnly declare that to the best of my knowledge and belief the foregoing particulars are true in every respect; and that there is not any impediment to the intended marriage (*and that the consent required under section 526 of the Niue Act 1966 has been obtained).

*Delete if not applicable

[Signature of party giving notice]

Declared before me, the undersigned, this day of 20

Marriage officer.

Niue 341

Reg. 5 Form 2

Niue

CONSENT TO MARRIAGE OF MINOR

I,

of

being the [State: “Father or Mother”]

of [Full name of party to marriage who is under age]

who was born on the

hereby consent to his (her) marriage with [Full name of other party to marriage]

–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––

Niue

MARRIAGE REGISTER

No.

Bridegroom

Bride

Name and surname

Age

Occupation

Status (i.e. bachelor, spinster, widower, widow, or divorced)

Birthplace

Usual residence

Father ’s name and surname

Father ’s occupation

Mother ’s name and surname

Married, after notice duly given to me as required by section 520 of the Niue Act 1966, this day of 20

[Signature of marriage officer]

342 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

This marriage was solemnised between us:


Signatures, places of abode, and calling of witnesses


Reg. 12 Form 4

Niue

CERTIFIED COPY OF ENTRY IN MARRIAGE REGISTER

Number

When married

Where married

Bridegroom

Bride

Name and surname

Age

Occupation

Status (i.e. bachelor, spinster, widower, widow, or divorced)

Birthplace

Usual residence

Father ’s name and surname

Father ’s occupation

Mother ’s name and surname

Certified to be a true copy of the above particulars included in an entry in the Marriage

––––––––––––––––––––

Niue 343

Reg. 18

SCHEDULE 2

FEES TO BE PAID TO REGISTRAR OF THE HIGH COURT

$

For every notice of intended marriage

0.50

For every marriage solemnised

4.00

For every certified copy of any entry in a Marriage Register, including search

1.00

Search or inspection of Marriage Register, in respect of each name or entry

0.20

––––––––––––––––––––

344 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

PENAL MANUAL 2006

2006/3 – 26 September 2006

1 Short title

2 Definitions

PART 1

GENERAL

3 Principles and purposes and of the penal system

4 General instructions

5 Admission and discharge

6 General provisions as to discipline and

control

7 Constables

8 Legal adviser

9 Visits

10 Release under special circumstances

11 Religion

PART 2

WELFARE OF INMATES

12 Education and library

13 Health

14 Accommodation, bedding and clothing

15 Food

16 Inmates awaiting trial

17 Inmates under the age of twenty-one

18 Inmates - good behaviour and remission

19 Inmates hours of work

20 Earning of inmates

21 Transfer of inmates to New Zealand

PART 3

DUTIES AND RESPONSIBILITIES OF PRISON OFFICERS

22 Management and control

23 Overall supervision

24 Keeping and maintaining official records

25 Prison officers and performance of duties

26 Instructions in the event of an emergency

27 Cases of emergency and lawful orders

28 Association other than in performance of

duties with inmates prohibited

29 Personal visitors’ alcohol prohibited

30 Employment grievances

31 Officers hours of work

PART 4

PAROLE SYSTEM

32 Parole Board

33 Eligibility for parole

34 Jurisdiction of the Controller

35 Term of parole

Niue 345

1 Short title

PART 1 GENERAL
This manual may be cited as the Penal Manual 2006.

2 Definitions

In this Manual –
“Controller” means the person appointed as Controller of Prisons for Niue;
“inmate” means a person confined in a prison to serve a sentence upon
conviction;
“Judge” in relation to the High Court, means any Judge of that Court;
“night or night – time” means the interval between half past six o’clock in
the evening and half past six o’clock in the morning”;
“offender on remand” means a person detained by any agency of the
Government of Niue, authorized to arrest and detain offenders;
“Superintendent” means the person appointed as superintendent of a
prison.

3 Principles and purposes and of the penal system

(1) The purpose of the corrections system is to improve public safety and
contribute to the maintenance of a just society by –
(a) Ensuring that the community-based and custodial sentences and
related orders that are imposed by the courts and the Parole Board
are administered in a safe, secure, humane, and effective manner;
and
(b) Providing for corrections facilities to be operated in accordance with
these regulations and the United Nations Standard Minimum Rules
for the Treatment of Prisoners; and
(c) Assisting in the rehabilitation of offenders and their reintegration
into the community, where appropriate, and so far as is reasonable
and practicable in the circumstances and within the resources
available, through the provision of programmes and other
interventions; and
(d) Providing information to the courts and the Parole Board to assist
them in decision-making.
(2) The principles that guide the operation of the corrections system are
that—
(a) The maintenance of public safety is the paramount consideration in decisions about the management of persons under control or supervision;
(b) Victims’ interests must be considered in decisions related to the management of persons under control or supervision;
(c) In order to reduce the risk of reoffending, the cultural background, ethnic identity, and language of offenders must, where appropriate and to the extent practicable within the resources available, be taken into account—
(i) in developing and providing rehabilitative programmes and other interventions intended to effectively assist the rehabilitation and reintegration of offenders into the community; and
(ii) in sentence planning and management of offenders;
346

Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

(d) Offenders must, where appropriate and so far as is reasonable and practicable in the circumstances, be provided with access to any process designed to promote restorative justice between offenders and victims;
(e) An offender ’s family must, so far as is reasonable and practicable in the circumstances and within the resources available, be recognised and involved in –
(i) decisions related to sentence planning and management, and the rehabilitation and reintegration of the offender into the community; and
(ii) planning for participation by the offender in programmes, services, and activities in the course of his or her sentence;
(f) The corrections system must ensure the fair treatment of persons under control or supervision by –
(i) providing those persons with information about the rules,
obligations, and entitlements that affect them; and
(ii) ensuring that decisions about those persons are taken in a fair
and reasonable way and that those persons have access to an
effective complaints procedure;
(g) Sentences and orders must not be administered more restrictively
than is reasonably necessary to ensure the maintenance of the law
and the safety of the public, corrections staff, and persons under
control or supervision;
(h) Offenders must, so far as is reasonable and practicable in the
circumstances within the resources available, be given access to
activities that may contribute to their rehabilitation and
reintegration into the community;
(i) Contact between prisoners and their families must be encouraged
and supported, so far as is reasonable and practicable and within
the resources available, and to the extent that this contact is
consistent with the maintenance of safety and security requirements.
(3) Persons who exercise powers and duties under these regulations must
take into account the principles set out in paragraph (2) that are applicable, so far
as is practicable in the circumstances.

4 General instructions

(1) There shall be a Controller who shall have the prime responsibility for
the application of the purposes and principles set out in regulation 3.
(2) (a) Except with the express permission of the Controller no person
(including any officer or employee of the Department of Police or of
Justice, Lands and Survey) is permitted to enter the prison compound
at any time.
(b)This rule does not apply to a person with whom the Controller has
made arrangements to conduct spiritual devotionals for the welfare
of inmates.
(3) (a) The Superintendent may refuse to admit to the prison any visitor
whose conduct is improper, and may for that purpose use or
authorize the use of such force as may be necessary.
(b)Incidents of such nature shall be reported immediately to the
Controller or appropriate authority.
(4) The prison cells for the detention of inmates shall be secured by locks
and keys retained by the Superintendent or his substitute who is on duty.

Niue 347

(5) The Niue Public Service Commission on advice of the Controller shall set the hours of duty to be observed by the Superintendent and other prison officers each day of the week or month, as the case may be and in accordance with regulation 31.

5 Admission and discharge of prisoners

(1) There shall be an admission register, in which there shall be entered in
respect of each inmate the following particulars –
(a) Information concerning his identity (name, sex, village or home
address, telephone number);
(b) Authority for his committal and offence committed;
(c) Admission and discharge dates;
(d) Other particulars as may be directed by the Controller.
(2) Every inmate upon admission shall be searched, and all property taken
from him shall be recorded and returned to him on the date of his release.
(3) The Superintendent shall be responsible for the safekeeping of inmates’
property while in prison custody.
(4) The Record Property Sheet shall be signed by the inmate, as
acknowledgement of receipt his property.

6 General provisions as to discipline and control

(1) Discipline and order shall be maintained with firmness and fairness.
(2) Treatment of inmates shall have regard to the aim of rehabilitation,
encouragement of self-respect and a sense of personal responsibility.
(3) Prison officers shall exercise the utmost care and vigilance in the custody
and surveillance of the inmates under his charge and shall not part with the custody
of an inmate.
(4) No prison officer shall use force in dealing with any inmate except in
self-defence or in defence of another person or in the case of escape or attempted
escape or active or passive physical resistance to a lawful order.
(5) Any prison officer who uses force subject to paragraph (4) shall report
the incident to the Controller as soon as possible.
(6) Every inmate must promptly obey every lawful order that is given to
him.
(7) Any inmate who considers himself aggrieved by an order must
nevertheless obey, but may on the first convenient occasion complain to the
Controller.
(8) Every inmate must keep their person, sleeping quarters, eating materials
and furniture in the highest state of cleanliness and tidiness.

7 Constables

(1) Any constable may visit any inmate provided the Superintendent is
present at the time of interview.
(2) If an inmate express unwillingness to see the Police the visit may be
terminated forthwith.

8 Legal adviser

(1) The legal adviser of any inmate may, with the prior permission of the
Controller interview the inmate on any legal business not pertaining to the
discipline of the prison.
(2) Any abuse of this privilege by the legal adviser or any assistant will
result in the approval being withdrawn automatically.
348 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

9 Visits

(1) Inmates shall be permitted to receive visitors on Saturdays and Sundays
or any week day provided the Superintendent is satisfied that the reason(s) given
are valid and may not affect the security or discipline of the Prison.
(2) The time allocated for each visitor shall be at the discretion of the
Superintendent and in special cases the approval of the Controller must be sought.
(3) Prison cells are out of bounds to visitors, except as provided under
paragraph (1).

10 Release

(1) The Controller may in special circumstances apply the following general
provisions –
(a) A weekend release may be granted for inmates serving a sentence
of 6 months or more and who is known to be a family man with a
spouse rearing a large or young family but such a release shall be
considered a privilege and can be taken away at any time;
(b) Temporary release to attend the wake and funeral of any local
member of the family may be granted to any inmate provided a
request is made to the Controller;
(c) Inmate(s) on a weekend or temporary release is responsible for their
own transport to and from the prison custody;
(d) In every other case the application by inmates for a temporary
release shall be considered on merits.
(2) The Controller alone shall be responsible for dealing with the application
of paragraph (1).

11 Religion

PART 2
WELFARE OF INMATES
(1) The Controller may enter into arrangements with any church or organization for the appointment of a Minister of religion to conduct services and religious observances once a week.
(2) With the approval of the Controller, services may be held at the prison compound on Sundays, Good Friday or Easter holiday and Christmas Day.
(3) Any Minister of religion may at convenient times, visit any inmate for
whom he or she has pastoral responsibility, subject however to prior arrangements
with the Controller or the Superintendent.
(4) The Controller may exempt any inmate from working on any day of
his recognized days of religious observances.

12 Education and library

(1) Inmates interested in furthering their education by correspondence or
other means may be permitted to do so by special arrangements with the Controller.
(2) There shall be a prison library providing reading materials for inmates
and to be opened at times and dates approved by the Superintendent.

13 Health

(1) Notwithstanding regulation 4(2) the medical officer shall visit the prison
at such periods as may be specified by the Controller or any other time as requested
by the Superintendent.
(2) This condition also applies to the professional services provided by the
Dental Officer in the case of dental problems.

Niue 349

(3) The Superintendent or any prison officer on duty shall provide the medical or dental officer any information relevant to the cause of health problems of any inmate.
(4) Inmates suffering from any contagious or infectious disease may be removed from the prison on recommendation of the medical officer provide however the Controller is informed prior to the inmate’s removal from custody.
(5) The Superintendent shall immediately notify the Controller, and where practicable, the next of kin of the deceased whenever any inmate –
(a) Becomes seriously ill or suffers injury;
(b) Removed to the hospital; or
(c) Suffers death.
(6) The Superintendent shall at once inform an inmate of any intimation
he receives of the death or serious illness of any near relative of the inmate.

14 Accommodation, bedding and clothing

(1) Prison cells are provided to accommodate no more than four inmates
at any one time and such arrangements must comply with the prevailing health
standard.
(2) A separate bunk bed is provided for each inmate in each of the cells,
and following the usual practice, inmates are expected to supply their own personal
bedding as well as outdoor working clothes, except in special cases where
circumstances demand the prison authority may supply the needs of an inmate
but not otherwise.
(3) Washing facilities are also available for inmates to wash their own
clothes at times approved by the Superintendent.

15 Food

(1) Every inmate shall be supplied with a sufficient quantity of wholesome
food, but generally the diet shall on each day consist of –
Bread or hard biscuits 1/2 loaf or 1/2 dozen biscuits per inmate per day.
Tin of meat/fish 1/2 tin of meat/fish per inmate per day.
Sugar, milk and tea sufficient supply per day.
Rice or any substitute sufficient for an evening meal or 1 bowl of rice per
day per inmate.
Local food/vegetable when available
(2) (a) Provisions for special diet can be arranged on recommendation of
a medical officer.
(b) Basic cooking facilities and utensils are available for inmates to cook
their own food.
(c) Cooking utensils, plates and cups used for serving food and drink
must be washed and kept clean at all times.
(3) Notwithstanding the standard supply of food and diet listed above
every effort shall be made by the prison authority to initiate and foster planting
programmes under supervision that would eventually lead to the prison being
self – sufficient in local food supplies both in vegetables and fresh local meat.
350 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

16 Inmates awaiting trial

(1) An offender awaiting trial must not under any circumstances be placed
in a cell which has already been occupied by an inmate and shall, as far as
practicable be kept apart from other inmates.
(2) The expression offender awaiting trial means an offender detained only
by reason of fact that he is awaiting trial or is in remand during the trial or before
sentence.
(3) Any interview between an offender awaiting trial and his legal adviser
may be held in sight, but not within the hearing of a prison officer.
(4) Every offender awaiting trial shall be permitted to procure at his own
expense or receive from his friends reasonable quantities of food and other
necessities for his own use.
(5) An offender awaiting trial is not required to work unless he volunteers
to do so.

17 Inmates under the age of twenty-one

Except during working hours, library or income working projects an
offender(s) awaiting trial or an inmate under the age of 21 years shall be kept in a
cell separately from other inmates over that age.

18 Inmates good behaviour and remission

(1) An inmate serving an imprisonment sentence of 3 to 6 months
maximum shall be allocated marks on the basis of good behaviour and diligence.
(2) The maximum number of marks which an inmate may be allocated
per day is limited to five only.
(3) (a) For the purpose of the partial remission of sentences, every 15 marks
allocated shall represent one day’s remission.
(b) The Controller may, in recommending or granting any such
remission, take into account any other matter he considers relevant
to an assessment of the inmates good conduct and diligence during
his sentence.
(4) An inmate shall be notified of the number of marks (if any) of any
remission represented by those marks at the end of each month.

19 Inmates hours of work

The following is the standard working hours:
Monday to Friday - 6am to 5.00pm with 1 hour break for lunch.
Saturday - 7:30am to 12.00pm. Afternoon for general clean up and
laundry needs.
Sunday - rest day but confined to prison compound.
Christmas/New Year/
Constitution Day - free but confined to prison compound.

20 Provision as to earning of inmates

Income earning projects are subject to separate and special arrangements
as determined by the Controller.

21 Transfer of inmates to New Zealand

Provisions relating to the transfer of inmates are contained in section 243 of
the Niue Act 1966.

Niue 351

PART 3
DUTIES AND RESPONSIBILITIES OF PRISON OFFICERS

22 Management and control

(1) The Superintendent is charged with the control, management, order,
and discipline of the prison, safe custody of inmates, and all Government property.
(2) At least once a week and on uncertain hours he shall visit the prison at
night and satisfy himself that all is in order.
(3) The Superintendent shall not be away from the vicinity of the prison
for more than 24 hours at a time without previously notifying the Controller.
(4) Before leaving the prison on any occasion he shall transfer charge to
his deputy or to the prison officer whom under these instructions is answerable to
the Controller for the control and supervision duties.
(5) If he is unable through sickness to perform his duties he shall transfer
charge to his deputy and report absence to the Controller.
(6) In the absence of the Superintendent, the Deputy shall have charge of
the prison and responsible in the same manner as the Superintendent.
(7) The Deputy Superintendent shall have such other powers to carry out
duties as delegated by the Superintendent.

23 Overall supervision

(1) The Superintendent shall exercise a close and constant personal
supervision of the whole prison, and shall see as far as practicable that each inmate
is known to him.
(2) He shall at reasonable intervals inspect all parts of the prison and shall
give special attention to any inmate who is sick or under restraint or undergoing
confinement in a cell or upon restricted intake of food or diet.
(3) He shall satisfy himself that all occupied prison cell are locked at
appropriate times, and keys are kept at the authorised place or in possession of
the officer of duty.
(4) He shall require reports accounting for all inmates to be made to him at
the hour of final lock – up, at such times as inmates go and return from work and
at such times as he considers necessary.
(5) The Superintendent shall report promptly to the Controller whenever
any inmate –
(a) Escapes; or
(b) Is captured after an escape; or
(c) Is placed under mechanical restraint; or
(d) Involved in an accident.
(6) The Superintendent may at any time refuse to allow any person access
to the prison compound if there is cause to suspect that liquor or any prohibited
item is to be brought into the compound.

24 Keeping and maintaining official records

The Superintendent shall cause to be kept the following record books and
such other books and records as may from time to time be directed by the
Controller:
(a) Admission register including information on discharge;
(b) Inmates Property Record book;
(c) File containing Warrants;
(d) Lock-up Report book;
(e) Punishment Record book;
(f) Official Visitors’ book; and
(g) Visitors’ book.
352 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

25 Prison Officers and performance of duties

(1) Every prison officer shall perform such duties as the Superintendent
directs from time to time, and carry out any extra or special duty when directed.
(2) Unless the Controller directs otherwise, the control of the prison shall
in the absence of the Superintendent and his Deputy fall on the next senior prison
officer.
(3) Any prison officer who is in charge of the prison under paragraph (2) shall for the time being be responsible as if he were the Superintendent, and shall exercise all powers vested by this Penal Manual in the Superintendent.

26 Instructions in the event of an emergency

(1) The Superintendent shall cause to be prepared a set of instructions to
be followed in the event of any emergency such as fire or hurricanes and shall
note these instructions and any change subsequently made to him in his order
book.
(2) He shall see that all inmates are fully instructed in their duties in the event of fire or hurricanes, and shall ensure that appropriate authorities are informed promptly.

27 In cases of emergency and lawful orders

(1) In any case of emergency every prison officer under the control of the
Superintendent is expected to act promptly, to use his own judgment, and to
exercise initiative.
(2) Every officer shall obey without question any lawful order given by
the Superintendent or his substitute, but he may afterwards appeal to the Controller
if he by any reason disagrees with the order given at the time.

28 Association other than performance of duties with inmates prohibited

(1) Except in the performance of his official duties no prison officer shall
associate in nay way with any of the inmates under his charge.
(2) No officer at any time shall receive any money, reward, trades; enter
into an agreement or benefit of any kind from or on behalf of any inmate.
(3) Unless authorized in writing by the Controller no officer shall purchase
any article from, belonging or made in prison, or have work done for him by an
inmate.

29 Personal visitors - alcohol prohibited

(1) Except with the permission of the Controller, no officer shall be
permitted to receive or take personal visitors within any part of the prison other
than the officer ’s quarters.
(2) No officer shall have or use intoxicating liquor within any part of the
prison compound or within close proximity to the inmates’ quarters.

30 Employment grievances

(1) Any officer wishing to bring any matter before the Controller may make
a written statement to the Superintendent, who shall forthwith forward the
statement with his comments to the Controller.
(2) Any officer may elect to join the Niue Public Service Association and
may either alone or in company with any other officer make representation to the
Association on any matter relating to the salaries, wages, allowances, uniforms or
condition of employment of officers.

Niue 353

31 Prison officers hours of work

(1) The Superintendent is required to work standard working hours each
day or week days as prescribed by the Commission under regulation 40 of the
Public Service Regulations 2004.
(2) For any other prison officer the Commission on the advice of the
Controller shall prescribe the hours of work each day but generally under a weekly
or monthly roster system as deemed appropriate.

32 Parole Board

PART 4
PAROLE SYSTEM
The Parole Board established under section 286A of the Niue Act 1966 and shall together with Parole Officers administer the parole system.

33 Eligibility for parole

(1) Every offender shall be eligible for consideration by the Minister for
Justice for release on parole upon recommendation by the Controller of Prison or
upon the expiry of the following periods since serving the prison sentence –
(a) 10 years in the case of every offender undergoing imprisonment
for life, having been sentenced to death and the sentence having
been commuted to life imprisonment;
(b) 8 years in the case of every other offender undergoing imprisonment
for life;
(c) 1 year after the expiration of one – half of the term of the sentence,
whatever period is longer in the case of every offender undergoing
a sentence of one – year or more than a sentence of life
imprisonment.
(2) In considering any case under parole the Minister shall not be required
to interview the offender.

34 Jurisdiction of the Controller

The Chief of Police through the Parole Officer shall have jurisdiction in
respect of persons released on parole after serving a sentence in prison.

35 Term of parole

Where any offender who is detained under sentence of imprisonment for a
year or more, not being imprisoned for life, is released from detention before the
expiry of the minimum term for which he is liable to be detained under sentence,
he shall be on parole, from the time of release, until the expiry of the term of his
sentence, or for one year if the unexpired part of that term is less than a year.

36 Term of parole to be deemed part of sentence

Whenever any person detained under any sentence is released on parole
before the expiry of the sentence, the term of the sentence shall continue to run
while he is on parole as if he were still serving the sentence.
354 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

37 Conditions of parole

(1) Where any offender is released on parole the following general
conditions shall apply –
(a) He shall report in person to the Parole Officer whose office is located
as appointed by the Commission, within 24 hours after his release
on parole;
(b) He shall give the Parole under whose supervision he is for the time
being, reasonable notice of his intention to move from his village of
residence to any other village or district, together with the nature
and place of his employment;
(c) He shall not reside at an address that is not approved by the Parole
Officer;
(d) He shall not continue in any employment that is not approved by
the Parole Officer;
(e) He shall not associate with any specified person, or with persons of
any specified class, with whom the Parole Officer has, in writing,
warned him not to associate; and
(f) He shall be of good behaviour and shall not commit any offence
against the law.
(2) Every paroled offender shall be under the direct supervision of a Parole
Officer.
(3) Any paroled offender through the Parole Officer may at any time apply
to the Controller for the remission, suspension or variation of any general or special
condition of parole, and the Controller may, and in writing, suspend the condition
until the application has been heard by the Court.
(4) The Parole Officer may apply to the Court through the Controller for
the imposition of any additional condition of parole in respect of any paroled
offender under his supervision.

38 Breach of conditions of parole

(1) Every paroled offender who contravenes or fails to comply with any
condition of his parole shall be dealt with in accordance with regulation 38(1).
(2) Where any Parole Officer or any cibstabke believes on reasonable
grounds that any paroled offender had committed a breach of a condition of his
parole, he may arrest the offender without a warrant and to dealt with in accordance
with section 101 of the Niue Act 1966.

39 Recall of offender released on parole

(1) (a) The Controller may, at any time while an offender is released on
parole, direct that the offender be recalled.
(b) On the giving of the direction, the parole shall be deemed to be
cancelled and the offender may be arrested without warrant by any
constable, and shall be detained and shall continue to serve his
sentence unless he is again released on the recommendation of some
reputable person or persons of the village where the parole offender
resided.
(c) Such a release shall not operate to extend term of the offender ’s
parole, beyond the date on which that term would have expired
had he not been recalled.
(2) The authority conferred in paragraph (1) above may be exercised on
such grounds as the Controller thinks fit, and whether or not the offender has
committed a breach of the conditions of his parole.

Niue 355

40 Appointment of parole officers

The Niue Public Service Commission may appoint any person or the holder
for the time being of any office or appointment in the Niue Public Service as a
Parole Officer.

41 Duties and responsibilities

(1) The Parole Officer may, and shall when required by the Controller,
report on the character and personal history of any person released on parole or
undergoing a sentence of imprisonment with a view of assisting the Controller in
determining the most suitable method of dealing with his case; and may in such
report advise the Controller whether the offender would be likely to respond
satisfactory to parole and whether special condition of parole should be imposed.
(2) Every Parole Officer shall –
(a) Supervise all persons placed under his supervision, with a view of
assisting their social rehabilitation and preventing the commission
of further offences; and
(b) Perform such other duties as directed by the Court or the Controller.

42 Administration

PART 5
PROBATION SERVICE
Regulations 42 to 49 shall be administered by the Controller under the jurisdiction of the High Court.

43 Probation orders issued by Court

(1) Any person convicted by Court of any offence punishable by
imprisonment, may in its discretion, instead of sentencing him to prison, release
the offender on probation for a period specified by the Court, being generally a
period not less than 1 year and not more than 3 years.
(2) Where an offender is released on probation, the Court may also at the
same time make an order to pay any fine authorized by law and impose any
additional orders as it thinks fit.
(3) (a) Any offender sentenced to imprisonment for a term less than 1 year
may be considered for release on probation for a period not
exceeding 1 year upon terms and conditions specified by the Court.
(b) In any such case the offender released on probation shall be under
the supervision of the Probation Officer.
(4) In the event of any appeal or an application for leave to appeal, a release
on probation shall be deemed to be a sentence, or if a fine is imposed, to be part of
the sentence.
(5) Where any person is released on probation it is the duty of the Registrar
to notify the Probation Officer accordingly.
(6) Where any person is released on probation the Probation Officer shall
issue the probationer with a written notice setting out the conditions subject to
which he has been released.
356 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

44 Conditions of release

Where any person is released on probation, the following general conditions
shall be used as guidelines –
(a) To report to the Probation Officer immediately upon his release on
probation and shall further report to endorse the probation register
if and when he is required to do so by the Probation Officer;
(b) To give to the Probation Officer reasonable notice of his intention
to move away from his usual place of residence and his new address,
the nature and place of employment;
(c) Not to reside at an address that is not approved by the Court or
Probation Officer;
(d) Not to continue in any employment or continue to engage in any
occupation that is not approved by the Court or Probation Officer;
(e) Not to associate with any specified person or persons of any
specified group, with whom the Court or Probation Officer has, in
writing, warned him not to associate;
(f) He shall be in good behaviour and commit no further offence against
the law;
(g) To be engaged on approved community service or national projects
or any other work considered to be of some benefit to the people or
island as a whole.

45 Additional conditions may be imposed by Court

The High Court in releasing any person on probation may impose additional
conditions as it thinks fit or on the basis of the following –
(a) Direct the probationer to remain within his usual place or residence
or village throughout the entire period of the term of his probation;
(b) Direct the probation not to attend social gatherings or night spots
within or outside of his usual place of residence or village;
(c) Direct the probationer to make good the loss or damage to the
property for which he was convicted for or pay full restitution or
compensation for loss suffered by any person through or by means
of any such offence for which he was found guilty and conviction
ordered accordingly;
(d) Direct the probationer to abstain from the use of intoxicating liquor
or drugs;
(e) Direct the probationer not to associate with any specified person or
with persons of any specified group or class;
(f) Direct the probationer to undergo any specified course of education
or training, including regular attendance to any specified church
organisation;
(g) For ensuring his good conduct or for preventing the commission of
further offences.

46 Breach of conditions of probation

(1) Every probationer who fails to abide by the terms and conditions of his
probation is liable to be prosecuted under section 101 of the Niue Act 1966.
(2) Where any probationer is convicted under the provision specified in
paragraph (1), the Court may, in addition to or instead of sentencing the offender,
do all or any of the following things, namely –

Niue 357

(a) Extend the term of probation by any specified period expiring not more than 3 years;
(b) Vary any condition of the probation imposed earlier by the Court; (c) Impose additional conditions.
(3) Where any probationer or any constable believes on reasonable grounds that any probationer has committed a breach of any condition of his probation, he may arrest the probationer without warrant, to be dealt with in accordance with section 101 of the Niue Act 1966.

47 Probation Officer’s report

(1) Where a written report is made to the Court by a Probation Officer, a
copy of the report shall be given to the counselor or public defender appearing for
the offender, or if the offender is not represented by counsel or public defender, to
the offender.
(2) The offender of his counsel or public defender, may tender evidence
on any matter referred to in any report whether in written form or otherwise, by
the Probation Officer.
(3) The prosecution, in the like manner, is also entitled to receive a copy of
every report submitted by a Probation Officer to the Court.
(4) Every report submitted by the Probation Officer shall generally cover
the following –
(a) Full Christian and family names of the offender including alias (if
any);
(b) Age and date of birth and marital status (married/single);
(c) Brief details of the offence(s) committed by the offender together
with the relevant sections of the Act to which the charge(s) are made
against him;
(d) Maximum penalty stipulated by law;
(e) Details of previous offences and penalties imposed;
(f) Father/mother ’s names and their current address;
(g) Names of children (if any) and their birth dates;
(h) Detailed education background of the offender;
(i) Employment (if any);
(j) Religion;
(k) Financial status;
(l) Health; and
(m) General observation and comments.

48 Procedure for sentence on original sentence

(1) Any probationer, including a probationer who, in addition to being
released on probation, was also sentenced to pay a fine is convicted of an offence
committed during the period of probation, the Court may, sentence him for the
offence for which he was originally charged and released on probation.
(2) Every application filed by the Probation Officer in terms of regulation
45(3) shall be served on the probationer followed by a summons unless the
probationer is already in custody.
358 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(3) Any application made under this section shall be disposed of in the following manner:
(a) In the case of the offender released on probation by the Justice of the Peace the application shall be dealt with by the Commissioner of the High Court;
(b) In the case of the offender released on probation by the
Commissioner of the High Court, the application shall be dealt with
by the Judge;
(c) In the case of the offender released on probation by the Judge of the
High Court the application shall be dealt by the Chief Justice; or
(d) In case of the offender released on probation by the Chief Justice,
the application shall be dealt with by the Court of Appeal.
(4) The Commissioner or Judge or Chief Justice by whom an application is
heard under this section, may if he thinks fit, deal with the offender for the offence
for which he was released on probation in any way, other than releasing him again
on probation.

49 Effect of subsequent sentence on probation

(1) Where any person released on probation is sentenced in respect of any
offence for a term of one year or more, the probation shall be deemed terminated.
(2) Where any person released on probation is sentenced in respect of any
offence to imprisonment less than one year the term of his probation shall continue
to run while he is detained under sentence, and on his release from detention , he
shall continue to be on probation for the then unexpired residue of that term,
unless he is sooner discharged from probation by an order of the Court.

50 Discharge on expiry of probation

Every probationer shall at the expiry of the term of his or her probation be
deemed to be discharged in respect of the offence for which he or she was released
on probation as if he or she had been sentenced and had served the term of his or
her sentence.

51 Appointment of Probation Officers

(1) The Niue Public Service Commission shall be responsible for the
appointment of any person, or the holder for the time being of any office or
appointment in the Niue Public Service, as a Probation Officer.
(2) Any appointment made under the Public Service Regulations 2004 may
be held in conjunction with any office or appointment that is not deemed
inconsistent with other employment being held.
(3) Any person appointed subject to this section shall be responsible to the
Controller.

52 Duties and responsibilities

(1) It is the duty of the Probation Officer, when so required by any Court
or the Controller, to report on the character and personal history of any person
convicted of any offence punishable by imprisonment, with a view of assisting
the Court in determining the most suitable method of dealing with his case, and
may in such report advise the Court whether the offender would be likely to
respond satisfactory to probation and whether any special probation condition
should be imposed.

Niue 359

(2) Generally it shall be the duty of every Probation Officer to –
(a) Supervise all persons placed under his supervision, with a view to
assisting their social rehabilitation and preventing the commission
of further offences;
(b) Perform such other duties as may be specified elsewhere under
these instructions or directed by the Court or the Controller; and
(c) Appear in any proceedings in any Court and make presentation
when called upon to do so.
(3) In the exercise of his duties, every probation officer shall have the same
general power, protection and privilege of a constable.

53 Discretionary powers

(1) For proper control and supervision purposes the Probation Officer in
the exercise of his duties pursuant to regulation 51 or any other provisions shall,
in consultation with the Controller, cause to centralize the probation in small groups
depending on the nature of the project or an approved work programme.
(2) Every application by recognized sports, church or social organizations,
local government bodies or government departments for service under probation
system shall be determined according to its merits and by reference to regulation
44(f) provided requests are made in writing to the Controller.
PART 6
PRISON DISCIPLINE

54 Offences against discipline

(1) The following are offences against prison discipline –
(a) Disobedience of lawful orders given by any officer of the prison;
(b) Disobedience of any rules of the prison;
(c) Using obscene or improper language;
(d) Indecent behaviour;
(e) Creating a disturbance;
(f) Using insulting or threatening language to any officer or other
prisoner;
(g) Wilfully injuring or destroying any article belonging to the prison;
(h) Receiving or using articles prohibited by rules;
(i) Refusal to work, or negligence or idleness at work;
(j) Disrespect towards any prison officer, or towards the Medical
Officer, chaplain or visiting priests or any visitor, or person
employed in connection with the prison;
(k) Committing a nuisance;
(l) Refusing or neglecting to use, take, or apply the medicines or
remedies ordered by the Medical Officer;
(m) Making repeated groundless complaints; and
(n) Wilfully giving or causing unnecessary trouble.
(2) Punishment in respect of a prison offence may be imposed by the
Superintendent of the prison.
(3) The Superintendent may handcuff or place and keep in separate
confinement any prisoner whose conduct is so violent as to render that necessary.
(4) The Superintendent shall report each case of restraint of a prisoner and
the imposition of a punishment of a disciplinary offence in writing to the Controller
as soon as possible after that event.
(5) A prisoner who has been ordered to be punished for a disciplinary
offence may appeal against that punishment to the controller.
360 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(6) Where an appeal is made to a Controller under paragraph (5), the Controller shall consider the report provided by the Superintendent and any evidence the prisoner presents.
(7) The decision of the Controller on the appeal shall be final.

55 Offences by inmates relating to drugs and alcohol

(1) Every inmate commits an offence against discipline who without the
authority of a medical officer, uses any drug or consumes alcohol (whether inside
or outside a prison).
(2) Every person commits an offence against discipline who, without the
authority of a medical officer, uses any drug or consumes alcohol during any period
while the person is on temporary release from custody under regulation 10.

56 Attempting or aiding commission of offence against discipline

Every inmate or person on temporary release from custody under regulation
10 who attempts to commit any offence against discipline, or who aids, counsels
or procures the commission of any such offence, is liable to be dealt with and
punished in the same manner as if he had committed the offence.

57 Minor or unintentional breaches of discipline

(1) As far as practicable in the circumstances and if appropriate, an officer
must deal with a minor or an unintentional breach of discipline by a prisoner in
the following manner –
(a) By stopping the breach of discipline and explaining the nature of
the breach to the prisoner committing the breach;
(b) By instructing the prisoner to correct his or her behaviour;
(c) By allowing the prisoner to make amends to any person aggrieved
by the breach.
(2) If a minor or an unintentional breach of discipline is not dealt with
under paragraph (1), does not prevent an inmate from being charged with a
disciplinary offence.
PART 7
COMPLAINTS PROCEDURE

58 Purpose and objectives of complaints procedure

The inmates complaints procedure has the following objectives –
(a) To enable complaints by a person who are or were under control of
supervision to be dealt with internally on a formal basis;
(b) To ensure that all persons under control or supervision are aware
of the complaints system and are able to make a complaint if and
whey they choose to do so, without fear of adverse consequences;
(c) To ensure that complaints are all reasonable steps are to taken to
investigate complaints in a fair, timely, and effective manner;
(d) To ensure that, if possible in the circumstances, complaints are dealt
with reasonably promptly and at the lowest and most informal level;
(e) To ensure that complainants are advised of the progress in
investigating their complaints.

Niue 361

59 Prison, parole office and probation office must have internal complaints procedure

(1) In the prison, parole office and probation office, there must be an internal complaints procedure that enables complaints to be dealt with internally on a formal basis.
(2) The Controller or controlling officer of the parole and probation office
must ensure that the internal complaints procedure for that place complies with
the objectives set out in regulation 27.
(3) Notices must be prominently displayed in each cell in the prison, in
each parole and probation office, that explain –
(a) The complaints investigations process generally; and
(b) How persons under control or supervision may request interviews
or making formal complaints; and
(c) The right of persons under control or supervision to request, at any
time, assistance from the Superintendent or Controller.

60 Assistance to make complaints

(1) The Superintendent must ensure that a person under control or
supervision is given the opportunity to –
(a) Obtain assistance to enable the person to make a complaint; or
(b) Verify any information recorded on a form or other document
outlining a complaint.
(2) The Superintendent must ensure that any person who is under control
or supervision who has difficulties with verbal or written communication is
provided with assistance –
(a) To complete any required documents; and
(b) To prepare or present his case.

61 Persons under or previously under control or supervision may seek assistance from Controller

A person who is or was under control or supervision may, at any time, seek assistance from the Controller for the purpose of making a complaint.

62 Investigation of complaints by Controller

(1) The Controller may investigate a complaint in any manner that he
considers appropriate (which may include, without limitation, referring the
complaint to another person for consideration).
(2) While investigating a complaint, the Controller must be given access
to –
(a) Any person within the prison, parole or probation office, or to any person at any other place (including a dwelling house) at which the complainant is or was detained or required to attend, work, or live; and
(b) Any other person who is or was responsible for –
(i) the supervision of a complainant while the complainant carries
or carried out his sentence or order; or
(ii) the performance of any escort or courtroom custodial duties in
relation to the complaint; and
(c) Any records held by an employee of the department or any other
person referred to in subparagraph (a) or (b) that are relevant to the
complaint.
362 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(3) If the Controller investigates a complaint, he must conduct the investigation reasonably promptly, and must inform the complainant and the other person concerned, promptly after the conclusion of the investigation, in a matter that he considers appropriate of –
(a) The result of the investigation; and
(b) Any further action that the inspector proposes to take in respect of
the complaint.
(4) The Controller must keep records of every complaint that he receives
and deals with.

63 Powers of entry and access by Controller

(1) For the purpose of performing any functions as the Controller, he may
at any time, enter the prison, parole or probation office, or any other place
(including a dwelling house) at which a person under control of supervision is or
was detained or required to attend, work, live, and gain access to –
(a) All parts of that place;
(b) All persons under control or supervision in that place;
(c) All persons with responsibility for the control or supervision of those
persons in that place, and visitors to that place;
(d) If the place is the prison, parole or probation office, all records stored
in that place that relate to –
(i) the place;
(ii) a person who is or was under control or supervision; or
(iii) an officer employed at that place.
(2) For the purpose of performing any functions as the Controller, he may
at any time, enter any vehicle that is or was being used for the transportation of
any person under control or supervision during any period of that person’s
detention.
(3) Despite regulation 62 (2) (a) and paragraphs (1) and (2) of this regulation,
the Controller –
(a) Must not enter a dwelling house without the consent of any person
who appears to be the occupier of the dwelling house;
(b) Must not enter any part of a place at which a person under control
or supervision is required to live, work, or attend (other than the
actual part of the place in or at which the person is required to live,
work, or attend) without the consent of the person who appears to
be the occupier of that place;
(c) Must not enter a vehicle that is not owned by the department, unless
the owner or driver of the vehicle consents to that entry.

64 Interviews with Controller

(1) If the Controller visits the prison, parole or probation office, or any
other place for the purpose of interviewing persons under control or supervision,
all the persons under control or supervision at that place are entitled to an interview
with the Controller.
(2) If the Controller visits the prison, parole or probation office, or other
place for a purpose other than to interview persons under control or supervision,
a person under control or supervision at that place may ask for an interview with
the inspector and that inspector may agree to the interview.
(3) No person under control or supervision may be required to disclose to
any person with responsibility for the control or supervision of that person the
reason why the person asked for an interview with the Controller.

Niue 363

65 Recommendations and directions of Controller

(1) The Controller may, either during or following the completion of an
investigation –
(a) Make any recommendations that he considers appropriate about
practices or procedures to any person who he considers is the
appropriate person to receive the recommendation;
(b) Issue any direction to a person with responsibilities for the control
or supervision of any person that he considers necessary to avoid
or reduce any immediate danger to the complainant or any other
person.
(2) A direction given under paragraph (1)(b) may be revoked at any time
by the Superintendent.
(3) If the Superintendent revokes a direction given under paragraph (1)(b)
he must promptly inform the Minister of that revocation and the reasons for it.
364 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SEA CARRIAGE OF GOODS ACT 1940

1940/31 (NZ) – 1 December 1946

1

Short title

10

Modification of Rules 4 and 5 of article 3 in

relation to bulk cargoes

PART 1

2-6 [Repealed]

PART 3

GENERAL PROVISIONS

PART 2

11

Lodging of claims for damage, short

CARRIAGE BY SEA FROM NIUE

delivery, and pillage

7

Application of Rules in Schedule

12

Bill of lading to be binding if signed by

8

Absolute warranty of seaworthiness not to

authorised person

be implied

13

Saving

9

Statement as to application of Rules to be

included in bills of lading

SCHEDULE

To amend the law relating to the carriage of goods by sea

1 Short title

This is the Sea Carriage of Goods Act 1940.

2-6 [Repealed by 2004/270]

PART 1
PART 2
CARRIAGE BY SEA FROM NIUE

7 Application of Rules in Schedule

Subject to this Act, the Rules contained in the Schedule shall have effect in
relation to and in connection with the carriage of goods by sea in ships from the
port in Niue to any port outside Niue.

8 Absolute warranty of seaworthiness not to be implied

There shall not be implied in any contract for the carriage of goods by sea
to which the Rules apply any absolute undertaking by the carrier of the goods to
provide a seaworthy ship.

9 Statement as to application of Rules to be included in bills of lading

(1) Every bill of lading or similar document of title issued in Niue which
contains or is evidence of any contract to which the Rules apply shall contain an
express statement that it is to have effect subject to the Rules as applied by this
Act.
(2) Every owner, charterer, master, or agent who issues any such bill of lading or similar document of title without complying with this section shall be liable on conviction to a fine of 2 penalty units.

Niue 365

10 Modification of Rules 4 and 5 of article 3 in relation to bulk cargoes

Where under the custom of any trade the weight of any bulk cargo inserted
in a bill of lading to which the Rules apply is a weight ascertained or accepted by
a third party other than the carrier or the shipper and the fact that the weight is so
ascertained or accepted is stated in the bill of lading, then, notwithstanding
anything to the contrary in the Rules, the bill of lading shall not be deemed to be
prima facie evidence against the carrier of the receipt of goods of the weight so
inserted in the bill of lading, and the accuracy of it at the time of shipment shall
not be deemed to have been guaranteed by the shipper.
PART 3
GENERAL PROVISIONS

11 Lodging of claims for damage, short delivery, and pillage

(1) (a) The agents in Niue of any ship not registered in Niue shall be
deemed to be the legal representatives of the master and the owner
or charterer of the ship after the departure of the ship from the port
at which she was discharged for the purpose of receiving and paying
claims for short delivery, damage, or pillage of cargo, and the
amount of any such claim may be recovered from the agents in any
court of competent jurisdiction.
(b) It shall be lawful for the agents, by notice in writing delivered to
the Financial Secretary, not later than 24 hours before the departure
of any ship, to decline to accept any responsibility under this section
in respect of that ship, in which case the master and some other
person approved by the Revenue Manager shall, before the ship is
allowed her clearance, enter into a joint and several bond in a sum
not exceeding the value of her cargo, as shown by the ship’s papers,
for the payment of any sum which, together with costs, may be
recovered against the agents of the ship.
(2) No proceedings for the recovery of any claim under this section shall
be taken unless notice in writing giving reasonable particulars of the damage or
loss is given to the agents and the proceedings commenced within one year after
the delivery of the cargo or the date when the cargo should have been delivered.
(3) Nothing in this section shall prevent the agents from raising any defence
available to their principal and, in particular but not in limitation, any defence
available to their principal by virtue of the provisions of Rule 6 of article 3 of the
rules relating to bills of lading contained in the Schedule.

12 Bill of lading to be binding if signed by authorised person

Every bill of lading or other shipping document relating to the carriage of
goods issued by the manager, agent, master, owner or charterer of a ship, and
signed by any person purporting to be authorised to sign it, shall be binding on
the master and the owner or charterer of the ship as if the bill of lading or other
document had been signed by the master.

13 Savings

Nothing in this Act shall affect the operation of section 15A of the Mercantile
Law Act 1908.
––––––––––––––––––––
366 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

SCHEDULE

RULES RELATING TO BILLS OF LADING

Article 1 – Definitions

In these Rules the following expressions have the meanings hereby assigned to them

respectively, that is to say –

(a) “carrier” includes the owner or the charterer who enters into a contract

of carriage with a shipper;

(b) “contract of carriage” applies only to contracts of carriage covered by a

bill of lading or any similar document of title, in so far as such document

relates to the carriage of goods by sea, including any bill of lading or any

similar document as aforesaid issued under or pursuant to a charter party

from the moment at which such bill of lading or similar document of title

regulates the relations between a carrier and a holder of the same;

(c) “goods” includes goods, wares, merchandise, and articles of every kind

whatsoever, except live animals and cargo which by the contract of

carriage is stated as being carried on deck and is so carried;

(d) “ship” means any vessel used for the carriage of goods by sea;

(e) “carriage of goods” covers the period from the time when the goods are

loaded on to the time when they are discharged from the ship.

Article 2 – Risks

Subject to Article 6, under every contract of carriage of goods by sea the carrier, in relation

to the loading, handling, stowage, carriage, custody, care, and discharge of such goods,

shall be subject to the responsibilities and liabilities, and entitled to the rights and

immunities hereinafter set forth.

Article 3 – Responsibilities and Liabilities

1 The carrier shall be bound, before and at the beginning of the voyage, to exercise

due diligence to –

(a) Make the ship seaworthy;

(b) Properly man, equip, and supply the ship;

(c) Make the holds, refrigerating and cool chambers, and all other parts of

the ship in which goods are carried fit and safe for their reception, carriage,

and preservation.

2 Subject to Article 4, the carrier shall properly and carefully load, handle, stow, carry, keep, care for, and discharge the goods carried.

3 After receiving the goods into his charge, the carrier, or the master or agent of the carrier, shall, on demand of the shipper, issue to the shipper a bill of lading showing, among other things –

(a) The leading marks necessary for identification of the goods as the same are furnished in writing by the shipper before the loading of such goods starts, provided such marks are stamped or otherwise shown clearly upon the goods if uncovered, or on the cases or coverings in which such goods are contained, in such a manner as should ordinarily remain legible until the end of the voyage;

(b) Either the number of packages or pieces, or the quantity, or weight, as the case may be, as furnished in writing by the shipper;

(c) The apparent order and condition of the goods:

Niue 367

Provided that no carrier, master, or agent of the carrier shall be bound to state or show in the bill of lading any marks, number, quantity, or weight which he has reasonable ground for suspecting not accurately to represent the goods actually received, or which he has had no reasonable means of checking.

4 Such a bill of lading shall be prima facie evidence of the receipt by the carrier of the goods as therein described under Rule 3(a), (b) and (c).

5 The shipper shall be deemed to have guaranteed to the carrier the accuracy at the time of shipment of the marks, number, quantity, and weight, as furnished by him, and the shipper shall indemnify the carrier against all loss, damages, and expenses arising or resulting from inaccuracies in such particulars. The right of the carrier to such indemnity shall in no way limit his responsibility and liability under the contract of carriage to any person other than the shipper.

6 Unless notice of loss or damage and the general nature of such loss or damage be given in writing to the carrier or his agent at the port of discharge before or at the time of the removal of the goods into the custody of the person entitled to delivery of it under the contract of carriage, or, if the loss or damage be not apparent, within 3 days, such removal shall be prima facie evidence of the delivery by the carrier of the goods as described in the bill of lading.

The notice in writing need not be given if the state of the goods has at the time of their receipt been the subject of joint survey or inspection.

In any event the carrier and the ship shall be discharged from all liability in respect

of loss or damage unless suit is brought within one year after delivery of the goods or the

date when the goods should have been delivered.

In the case of any actual or apprehended loss or damage the carrier and the receiver

shall give all reasonable facilities to each other for inspecting and tallying the goods.

7 After the goods are loaded the bill of lading to be issued by the carrier, master, or agent of the carrier to the shipper shall, if the shipper so demands, be a “shipped” bill of lading:

Provided that if the shipper shall have previously taken up any document of title to such goods he shall surrender the same as against the issue of the “shipped” bill of lading, but at the option of the carrier such document of title may be noted at the port of shipment, by the carrier, master, or agent with the name or names of the ship or ships upon which the goods have been shipped and the date or dates of shipment, and when so noted the same shall, for the purpose of this article, be deemed to constitute a “shipped” bill of lading.

8 Any clause, covenant or agreement in a contract of carriage relieving the carrier or the ship from liability for loss or damage to or in connection with goods arising from negligence, fault, or failure in the duties and obligations provided in this article or lessening such liability otherwise than as provided in these Rules shall be null and void and of no effect.

A benefit of insurance or similar clause shall be deemed to be a clause relieving the carrier from liability.

368 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Article 4 – Rights and Immunities

1 Neither the carrier or the ship shall be liable for loss or damage arising or resulting

from unseaworthiness unless caused by want of due diligence on the part of the carrier to

make the ship seaworthy, and to secure that the ship is properly manned, equipped, and

supplied, and to make the holds, refrigerating and cool chambers, and all other parts of

the ship in which goods are carried fit and safe for their reception, carriage, and

preservation under Rule 1 of Article 3.

Whenever loss or damage has resulted from unseaworthiness, the burden of proving the

exercise of due diligence shall be on the carrier or other person claiming exemption under

this rule.

2 Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be responsible for loss or damage arising or resulting from –

(a) Act, neglect, or default of the master, mariner, pilot, or the servants of the carrier in the navigation or in the management of the ship;

(b) Fire, unless caused by the actual fault or privity of the carrier;

(c) Perils, dangers, and accidents of the sea or other navigable waters;

(d) Act of God;

(e) Act of war;

(f) Act of public enemies;

(g) Arrest or restraint of princes, rulers, or people, or seizure under legal

process;

(h) Quarantine restrictions;

(i) Act or omission of the shipper or owner of the goods, his agent or

representative;

(j) Strikes or lockouts or stoppage or restraint of labour from whatever cause,

whether partial or general;

(k) Riots and civil commotions;

(l) Saving or attempting to save life or property at sea;

(m) Wastage in bulk or weight or any other loss or damage arising from

inherent defect, quality, or vice of the goods;

(n) Insufficiency of packing;

(o) Insufficiency or inadequacy of marks;

(p) Latent defects not discoverable by due diligence;

(q) Any other cause arising without the actual fault or privity of the carrier,

or without the fault or neglect of the agents or servants of the carrier; but

the burden of proof shall be on the person claiming the benefit of this

exception to show that neither the actual fault or privity of the carrier nor

the fault or neglect of the agents or servants of the carrier contributed to

the loss or damage.

3 The shipper shall not be responsible for loss or damage sustained by the carrier or the ship arising or resulting from any cause without the act, fault, or neglect of the shipper, his agents, or his servants.

4 Any deviation in saving or attempting to save life or property at sea, or any reasonable deviation shall not be deemed to be an infringement or breach of these Rules or of the contract of carriage, and the carrier shall not be liable for any loss or damage resulting therefrom.

Niue 369

5 Neither the carrier nor the ship shall in any event be or become liable for any loss or damage to or in connection with goods in an amount exceeding 200 dollars per package or unit, or the equivalent of that sum in other currency, unless the nature and value of such goods have been declared by the shipper before shipment and inserted in the bill of lading.

This declaration if embodied in the bill of lading shall be prima facie evidence,

but shall not be binding or conclusive on the carrier.

By agreement between the carrier, master, or agent of the carrier and the shipper another maximum amount than that mentioned in this rule may be fixed:

Provided that such maximum shall not be less than the figure above named.

Neither the carrier nor the ship shall be responsible in any event for loss or damage to or in connection with goods if the nature or value thereof has been knowingly misstated by the shipper in the bill of lading.

6 Goods of an inflammable, explosive, or dangerous nature to the shipment whereof the carrier, master, or agent of the carrier has not consented with knowledge of their nature and character may at any time before discharge be landed at any place or destroyed or rendered innocuous by the carrier without compensation, and the shipper of such goods shall be liable for all damages and expenses directly or indirectly arising out of or resulting from such shipment.

If any such goods shipped with such knowledge and consent shall become a danger to the ship or cargo, they may in like manner be landed at any place or destroyed or rendered innocuous by the carrier without liability on the part of the carrier except to general average, if any.

Article 5 – Surrender of Rights and Immunities, and Increase of Responsibilities and Liabilities

A carrier shall be at liberty to surrender in whole or in part all or any of his rights

and immunities or to increase any of his responsibilities and liabilities under the Rules

contained in any of these articles:

Provided such surrender or increase shall be embodied in the bill of lading issued

to the shipper.

The provisions of these Rules shall not be applicable to charter parties, but if bills

of lading are issued in the case of a ship under a charter party they shall comply with the

terms of these Rules. Nothing in these Rules shall be held to prevent the insertion in a bill

of lading of any lawful provision regarding general average.

Article 6 – Special Conditions

Notwithstanding the preceding articles, a carrier, master, or agent of the carrier,

and a shipper, shall in regard to any particular goods be at liberty to enter into any

agreement in any terms as to the responsibility and liability of the carrier for such goods,

and as to the rights and immunities of the carrier in respect of such goods, or his obligation

as to seaworthiness, so far as this stipulation is not contrary to public policy, or the care or

diligence of his servants or agents in regard to the loading, handling, stowage, carriage,

custody, care, and discharge of the goods carried by sea, provided that in this case no bill

of lading has been or shall be issued and that the terms agreed shall be embodied in a

receipt which shall be a non-negotiable document and shall be marked as such.

370 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Any agreement so entered into shall have full legal effect.

Provided that this article shall not apply to ordinary commercial shipments made

in the ordinary course of trade, but only to other shipments where the character or

condition of the property to be carried or the circumstances, terms, and conditions under

which the carriage is to be performed are such as reasonably to justify a special agreement.

Article 7 – Limitations on the Application of the Rules

Nothing herein contained shall prevent a carrier or a shipper from entering into

any agreement, stipulation, condition, reservation, or exemption as to the responsibility

and liability of the carrier or the ship for the loss or damage to or in connection with the

custody and care and handling of goods prior to the loading on and subsequent to the

discharge from the ship on which the goods are carried by sea.

Article 8 – Limitation of Liability

The provisions of these Rules shall not affect the rights and obligations of the

carrier under any statute for the time being in force relating to the limitation of the liability

of owners of sea-going vessels.

Article 9

The monetary units mentioned in these Rules are to be taken to be New Zealand

currency.

371

NIUE BANK

NIUE BANK REGULATIONS 1994

1994/1 – 8 June 1994

1 Title

These are the Niue Bank Regulations 1994.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Niue Bank Act 1994;
“advertisement” means any form of communication made to the public or
a section of the public for the purpose of promoting a Registered Bank,
a Registered Bank’s services, any security issued or to be issued by the
Registered Bank or any other matter related to the Registered Bank;
“Registered Bank” means a bank registered with the Niue Bank under Part
6 of the Act.

3 Administration of Acts

The Niue Bank shall administer the following Acts –
(a) –
(b) –
(c) The Trustee Companies Act 1994; and
(d) The Niue Development Bonds Act 1994.

4 Content of advertisements

(1) No advertisement shall contain any information, sound, image or other
matter that is likely to deceive, mislead, or confuse with regard to any particular
that is contained or referred to in the advertisement.
(2) No advertisement shall contain any information, sound, image, or other
matter that is inconsistent with any prospectus referred to in the advertisement.
(3) No advertisement that refers to a registered prospectus shall contain,
or be distributed with, a form of application to subscribe for securities.
(4) No advertisement shall state or imply that the securities to which it
relates are guaranteed by any person without also stating –
(a) The name of the guarantors; and
(b) The nature and amount of the guarantee; and
(c) Whether or not the guarantee is secured, and if so, the nature and
amount of the security:
Provided that subparagraphs (b) and (c) shall not apply if the Crown is the
guarantor and its guarantee is unconditional, or subject only to the condition that
the issuer or any other person has failed to repay the securities.
372 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(5) No advertisement shall –
(a) State the amount of assets or net assets, of any person or persons
other than the total assets, or net assets, of the issuing group of
borrowing group, or mortgagor under a contributory mortgage (as
the case may be), or of a guarantor of the securities to which the
advertisement relates; or
(b) State the amount of the total assets of the issuing group, borrowing
group or mortgagor under a contributory mortgage, or guarantor
without also stating with equal prominence the amount of the total
liabilities of the group, mortgagor or guarantor; or
(c) State the amount of net assets or the amounts of the assets and
liabilities in an issuing group, borrowing group, guarantor or
mortgagor unless under a contributory mortgage unless the
amounts shown appear in the most recent audited consolidated
balance sheet of the group, mortgagor, or guarantor (being a balance
sheet dated not earlier than 18 months before the date of distribution
of the advertisement) and the advertisement states the date of the
balance sheet as being the date at which the amount, or amounts,
have been calculated.
(6) No advertisement shall state the amount of the authorised capital or
issued capital of a registered bank unless the amount is described as such and the
advertisement also states with equal prominence, and describes as such, the
amount of the capital of the registered bank that is credited as paid up.
(7) No advertisement shall refer to any debt securities without also stating
that either that the securities are unsecured or the nature and ranking in point of
security of the securities.
(8) An advertisement shall not state or imply that participatory securities
are secured, other than by use of the words “secured” accompanied by a statement
of the nature and ranking in point of security of the securities.
(9) No advertisement shall contain a profit forecast unless the
advertisement refers to a registered prospectus and the profit forecast is also
combined in the registered prospectus.
(10) No advertisement shall be distributed to the public unless the
certificate that complies with paragraph (11) has been completed in respect of the
advertisement at the time at which the advertisement is so distributed.
(11)A certificate for the purposes of paragraph (10) shall be in the form set
out in the Schedule and shall be signed –
(a) By a person authorised by the Board of Directors of the registered
bank to sign such certificates; or
(b) Where the registered bank has only one director resident in Niue
by that director; or
(c) In every other case by at least 2 persons, each of whom is one of the
following persons –
(i) A director of the registered bank to which the advertisement
relates; or
(ii) Where none of the directors of the registered bank resides in
New Zealand, a person authorised by the directors to sign such
certificate.
(12) Paragraph (10) shall not apply –
(a) In respect of an authorised advertisement that contains no
information or a matter other than ­

Niue Bank 373

(i) The name, business address, postal address, telephone number, and telex number of the registered bank and the logo customarily used by the registered bank; and
(ii) A description of any securities being offered, the terms of the relevant offer and a brief description of any rights or privileges attaching thereto; and
(iii) A statement of the rate or rates of interest (if any) that may be earned by holding any securities being offered;
(b) In respect of any advertisement if the only difference between the
advertisement and another advertisement in respect of which a
certificate that complies with paragraph (11) has been completed is
that a rate or rates of interest shown in one of the advertisements
differ from the rate or rates of interest shown in the other
advertisement.
(13) Every certificate completed in respect of an advertisement for the
purposes of this regulation shall be held by the registered bank to which the
advertisement relates for at least 12 months from the date of the last distribution
of the advertisement.
(14) (a) If a registered bank fails to comply with paragraph (13), the
registered bank and every principal officer thereof commits an
offence;
(b) It shall be a defence to a charge against a principal officer under
this provision if the defendant proves that the disposal of the
certificate by the registered bank took place without his knowledge
or against his advice.
(15) Without limiting paragraph (16), every person commits an offence
who –
(a) Being a publisher of a newspaper or magazine, distributes an advertisement to the public in contravention of paragraph (10) by means of that newspaper or magazine;
(b) Being the operator of a broadcasting station, distributes an advertisement to the public in contravention of paragraph (10) by means of a broadcasting station; or
(c) Being the exhibitor of a film distributes an advertisement to the public, in contravention of paragraph (10) by means of exhibition of that film:
Provided that it should be a defence to a charge under this paragraph if the defendant proves that, at the time the advertisement was so distributed, he had reasonable grounds to believe, and did believe, that a certificate that complied with paragraph (10) had been completed in respect of the advertisement.
(16) Without limiting paragraph (15), if an advertisement is distributed
to the public in contravention of paragraph (10), the registered bank and every
principal officer thereof, commits an offence:
Provided that it shall be a defence to a charge under this paragraph if –
(a) The defendant proves that the advertisement was distributed
without his knowledge or against his advice; or
(b) The defendant is a principal officer and he proves that, at the time
the advertisement was so distributed, he had reasonable grounds
to believe, and did believe, that a certificate that complied with
paragraph (10) had been completed in respect of the advertisement.
(17) Every person who commits an offence against paragraphs (10) to
(16) is liable on summary conviction to a fine not exceeding 50 penalty units.
374 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(18) No advertisement shall state or imply that any securities to which it relates are made or may become authorised trust investments without also stating any conditions that remain to be fulfilled before the securities qualify as authorised investments under the Trusts Act 1994.
(19) No advertisement shall state that investment in the securities to which it may relate is safe or free from risk.
(20) No advertisement shall state the rate or rates of interest that may be earned by holding securities unless the advertisement states any minimum amount or amounts of the securities that would have to be held and any minimum of period or periods during which the securities would have to be held, in order to earn that rate or those rates.
(21) No advertisement shall –
(a) State a rate of interest payable in respect of a security that has been
adjusted for the purposes of taking into account the incidence of
taxation of the interest; or
(b) Otherwise refer to the taxation of interest earned by holding
securities, except that, subject to paragraphs (1) and (2), an
advertisement may include a statement to the effect that in certain
circumstances there may be tax advantages in holding the securities
referred to in the investment and that (if applicable) there is set out
in a prospectus a full statement of those advantages.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

CERTIFICATE IN RESPECT OF ADVERTISEMENTS I (or We) certify that –

(a) I (or We have) –

*(i) read

*(ii) seen

*(iii) listened to, the advertisement described in the Schedule to this

certificate.

(b) The advertisement complies with the Niue Bank Act 1994 and the Niue

Bank Regulations 1994.

(c) The advertisement does not contain any matter that –

(i) is likely to deceive, mislead or confuse with regard to any material

particulars; or

*(ii) is inconsistent with any registered prospectus referred to in the

advertisement.

Signature of Director (or Authorised Signatory): .................................................................... Date of Signing: ...................................................

Signature of Director (or Authorised Signatory): .................................................................... Date of Signing: ...................................................

ADVERTISEMENT

(The description must be sufficient to enable the advertisement to be identified.)

*Delete if inapplicable

375

PARTNERSHIP

PARTNERSHIP AMENDMENT FEES REGULATIONS 1994

1994/4 – 8 June 1994

1 Title

These are the Partnership Amendment Fees Regulations 1994.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Partnership Application Act 1994;
“Registrar” means the Registrar appointed under section 11 of the Act.

3 Application fees

Where an application for registration of a limited liability partnership is
lodged with the Registrar under section 12 of the Act, it shall be accompanied by
a fee of $250.

4 Renewal fee

Where an application for renewal of registration of a limited liability
partnership is lodged with the Registrar under section 13 of the Act, it shall be
accompanied by a fee of $100.

5 Payment of fees

All fees prescribed by these Regulations shall be refundable if the relevant
application is declined.

376 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

377

PARTNERSHIP APPLICATION

PARTNERSHIP AMENDMENT FORMS REGULATIONS 1995

1995/2 – 1 July 19956

1

Title

4

Application for renewal of registration form

2

Interpretation

5

Guarantee form

3

Application for registration form

6

Certificate of registration form

1 Title

These are the Partnership Amendment Forms Regulations 1995.

2 Interpretation

In these Regulations –
“Act” means the Partnership Application Act 1994.

3 Application for registration form

Application for registration as Limited Liability Partnerships as required
under section 12(2) of the Act is to be in the form prescribed in Schedule 1.

4 Application for renewal of registration form

Application for renewal of registration as required under section 13(2) of
the Act is to be in the form prescribed in Schedule 2.

5 Guarantee form

The several guarantee from the partners as required under section 12(4) of
the Act is to be in the form prescribed in Schedule 3.

6 Certificate of registration form

The certificate of registration as required under section 12(6) of the Act is to
be in the form prescribed in Schedule 4.
––––––––––––––––––––
378 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
SCHEDULE 3
FORM LLP3 (Section 12(4))
IN THE MATTER of the PARTNERSHIP APPLICATION ACT 1994
AND
IN THE MATTER of [name of the applicant] DECLARATION OF GUARANTEE OF LIMITED LIABILITY PARTNERSHIP
We, ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................. , being the partners of
hereby guarantee to be severally liable to all creditors of the partnership to the sum of
$ ............................................ each.
Declared pursuant to section 12(4) of the Partnership Application Act 1994. Dated at this day of 1995. Signature: Witness:
..................................................................... ...............................................................
..................................................................... ...............................................................
..................................................................... ...............................................................
..................................................................... ...............................................................
..................................................................... ...............................................................
..................................................................... ...............................................................

Government of Niue

Office of the Registrar for Limited Liability Partnerships

Certificate of gistration(>«<;o., Ul

FORMLLP4

(Seetion 12(6))

S'

(':)

() (/')

;:::-

[Ij ·

LLPNo.

0c ;:r:,.

I, Registrar of Limited Liability Partnerships DO HEREBY CERTIFY that,

--.:::!

r-' --.:::!

[Ij ;::)·

>:::>

§·

was duly registered in Niue as a Limited Liability Partnership this day of 199

Given under my hand and seal

.··.................................................................... w

Registrar

380 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

381

PENSIONS AND BENEFITS

PENSIONS AND BENEFITS REGULATIONS 1998

1998/7 – 13 October 1988

1 Title

These are the Pensions and Benefits Regulations 1998.

2 [Spent]

3 Interpretation

In these Regulations, “Act” means the Pensions and Benefits Act 1991.

4 Rate of pension

The rate of pension payable under section 4 of the Act is –
(a) In the case of a person who has not attained the age of 70 years –
$2080 a year; and
(b) In any other case – $2210 a year.

5 Rate of welfare benefit

The maximum rate of benefit for the purpose of section 13 of the Act is –
(a) In the case of a person considered by the Welfare Committee to be
a person with a severe disability – $2210 a year; and
(b) In any other case – $1950 a year.

382 Niue Laws 2006 Vall

383

PUBLIC HEALTH

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The International Sanitary Regulations 1951 are not reproduced. The Regulations in current form may be accessed at: http:// www.searo.who.int/en/section10/section369_9695.htm]

NOTIFIABLE DISEASES NOTICE 1991

1991/6 – 1 October 1991

1 Title

This is the Notifiable Diseases Notice 1991.

2 Notifiable diseases

The diseases named in the Schedule are notifiable diseases for the purposes
of the Public Health Act 1965.
–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
Aids Plague
Cholera Relapsing fever
Dengue fever Smallpox
H.I.V. Virus Typhus
Leprosy Yellow Fever

384 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

385

PUBLIC REVENUES

TREASURY RULES 1960

the Reserve Bank of New Zealand in an account to be called the Niue
Administration Account.
(2) Public money kept in New Zealand on fixed deposit shall be kept at a
branch of the Bank of New Zealand in an account to be called the Niue Assembly
Cash Investment Account.
(3) (a) The Financial Secretary may remit to the Reserve Bank of New
Zealand to the credit of the appropriate account such public money
as in his opinion is not required in Niue for immediate disbursement
and he may invest or cause to be invested part or all of such money
either on fixed deposit or in such securities as in New Zealand are
authorised for the investment of public money.
(b) Nothing in paragraph (1) shall prevent the Treasury from investing
public money in Niue in a Post Office Savings Bank or in a bank in
Niue.
SIGNING OF CHEQUES

4 Cheques drawn on the Niue Administration Account or on any bank

account shall be signed by the Financial Secretary or other officer appointed by
Cabinet to act in his stead.
ACCOUNTING OFFICERS

5 Every accounting officer as defined by the Act shall be subject to these

rules and shall perform such duties, keep such books, and render such accounts
as are prescribed by these rules, or directed by the Financial Secretary.

6 Every accounting officer shall, if so required by the Financial Secretary, provide security for such sum and in such manner and form as the Financial Secretary directs for the due accounting for and payment of all money which comes into his charge, custody, or control.

7 If an accounting officer is requested to make a payment or accept a charge of credit, or take any other action which in his opinion is not lawfully authorised or is otherwise in incorrect, he must state his objection in writing to the head of his Department, who shall, if he disagrees with the officer, forthwith report the circumstances to the Financial Secretary.

386 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
AUTHORISATION OF EXPENDITURE

8 Cabinet shall authorise all expenditure provided for in the Appropriation

Act and may delegate to any officer or officers as he thinks fit such of his powers
to authorise expenditure as he deems necessary.
COLLECTION OF MONEY

9 Every person collecting, receiving, or having control over any money

payable into the Niue Government Account or into any deposit, or trust, or separate
account, is a Receiver within the meaning of these rules.

10 (1) The full amount of all collections of public money shall be paid to the

Treasury unless the Financial Secretary directs otherwise.
(2) Paragraph (1) shall not apply to public money required by statutory or other lawful authority to be otherwise dealt with, and all such money shall be dealt with under the statutory or other requirement.

11 Except where the Financial Secretary directs otherwise, there shall be given to every person paying any money to be credited as public money to the Niue Government Account or to any deposit, or trust, or other account of the Government, an official receipt in the form approved by and printed under the authority of the Treasury.

12 Public money shall not be involved with private funds.

13 Every Receiver shall keep a cash book in the form approved by the Financial Secretary and shall enter the amount of his collections and the manner of their disposal.

14 (1) The Financial Secretary shall prescribe the times and the manner in which each Receiver shall balance his cash book and forward a copy of the summary of it to the Financial Secretary.

(2) The cash book shall be balanced at least once each calendar month.

15 Money received by way of deposit shall be dealt with in the manner provided for the collection of other public money except where the Financial Secretary directs otherwise.

16 The Financial Secretary may at any time arrange for money held on deposit, and not immediately required, to be invested in a Post Office Savings Bank.

17 Receivers shall apply to the Treasury for all books of receipts required by them and for all forms of licence and certificate on the issue of which they are required to collect a fee.

PAYMENT OF MONEY

18 (1) All vouchers for the expenditure of public money shall be signed by an

officer designated a certifying officer.
(2) A certifying officer shall be appointed by Cabinet on the recommendation
of the head of his Department and shall have such duties and responsibilities as
to certification as are prescribed by the Financial Secretary.

Public Revenues

387

19 All expenditure of public money shall be approved by Cabinet to ensure that payment vouchers have been properly certified, that the charging of expenditure is correct as to vote, item and account, and that authority exists for the expenditure.

20 All claims on the Government must be entered on a voucher form approved by and printed under the authority of the Financial Secretary.

21 (1) Payment of salaries or wages to all persons employed in the Public Service shall, unless the Financial Secretary approves otherwise, be made in cash. (2) The Financial Secretary may, on receipt of a request in writing from the

person entitled to it, pay any such salary to a bank or Post Office Savings Bank for the credit of that person.

22 Officers or other persons travelling on Government service must obtain receipts for such disbursements as are directed by the Financial Secretary.

23 Payments of claims shall be made in such manner as the Financial Secretary may direct.

24 (1) Except in the case of payments, under a power of attorney, letters of administration, or probate, payments to other than claimants themselves may be made only under the authority of the claimants given in the form approved by the Financial Secretary.

(2) Any such authority may be either general or special.

25 (1) An authority under rule 24 shall be accepted by the Financial Secretary only for the convenience of claimants, who may revoke a general authority at pleasure.

(2) Authorities given by or on behalf of companies shall be signed by the directors or the managing director.
(3) The Financial Secretary shall not recognise or act upon any endorsement
or addition to a form of general authority which purports to make the authority
irrevocable or to alter in any way its substance or effect.
(4) A general authority must be renewed at the expiration of 2 years from
its date of it if it is desired to keep it in force for any longer period, otherwise the
Financial Secretary may regard the authority as cancelled.
(5) Orders made by employees of the Financial Secretary for the payment
of salary to a bank or Post Office Savings Bank or for allotment of part salary or
for deductions from salary shall remain in force until cancelled.

26 (1) No authority from a public servant for the payment of his salary to any person other than that employee shall be accepted by the Financial Secretary except where the employee is unable to receive the salary himself on account of absence from office or other cause.

(2) This rule does not apply to an authority for payment to a Bank or Post Office Savings Bank or to any allotment of part salary or deductions from salary approved by the Financial Secretary.

27 A public servant shall not, without the special approval in writing of the Financial Secretary, act as agent or attorney for the receipt of money due by the Government to a public creditor or claimant.

388 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
IMPRESTS

28 (1) Payments by way of imprest shall be made under instructions issued

by the Financial Secretary.
(2) The Financial Secretary shall direct the manner in which money shall be
issued to an imprestee and how he shall account for it.

29 Where imprests are issued to persons not in receipt of salary or allowances on Government service, those persons shall account for the same in the manner set forth in those rules and the instructions issued by the Financial Secretary.

30 The application by an imprestee, receiver, or other accounting officer of any public money under his control for any purpose other than the proper purposes for which that money is available shall be deemed to be a misappropriation of public money and he shall be liable accordingly.

RECEIPTS FOR PAYMENTS

31 (1) Except in special cases a receipt from the person legally entitled to receive

payment shall be accepted as sufficient discharge for any payment.
(2) The paying officer may at any time require to be furnished with
satisfactory evidence of the identity of a payee.
(3) The Financial Secretary may in any case require such further or other
instrument or discharge to be executed by the payee in addition to or instead of a
receipt, as may seem desirable in the circumstances.
(4) Where a receipt or endorsement does not appear to have been given or
made by the person legally entitled to receive payment personally, evidence may
be required of the authority of the person giving the receipt or making the
endorsement to give a legal discharge for the money paid.
(5) The mark of any payee unable to write must be witnessed by a person
other than the paying officer.
DEPARTMENTAL ACCOUNTS

32 (1) Government departments shall keep such accounts and accounting

records as the Financial Secretary may direct.
(2) The necessary forms for all books, accounts and documents required
by Departments for properly carrying into effect the provisions of these Rules
shall be such only as are prescribed or approved by the Financial Secretary.
(3) Where not inconsistent with these Rules the system of keeping
departmental accounts and accounting records and the books and forms to be
used shall at all times be subject to the control, supervision and inspection of the
Financial Secretary.

33 (1) It shall be the duty of every head of a Government department or other employee of the Government to afford all information which the Government may require regarding the receipt and expenditure of public money, and the accounting for public money or stores under his control.

(2) The Financial Secretary may instruct any officer of the Treasury to inspect any books, accounts, documents, or stores, or other public property held by any Government department and the head of any such department shall afford facilities for such inspection.

Public Revenues

389
STORES

34 (1) The Financial Secretary shall prepare rules and shall issue instructions

concerning the purchase, account for, management, control and disposal of public
stores.
(2) Losses of stores, deficiencies in stores, and damage to stores shall be reported to the Financial Secretary.

35 (1) Employees of the Government shall not, either directly or indirectly, derive advantage from dealing in public stores.

(2) Sales of stores to employees shall not be permitted without the authority of the Financial Secretary.
(3) Free issues to employees shall not be made unless authorised in writing by the Financial Secretary.
WRITING OFF MONEY OR STORES

36 No losses or deficiencies shall be included in the Annual Appropriation

Act for discharge from the Niue Assembly Account except those previously
concurred in by the Audit Office and the Cabinet.

37 No employee of the Government shall write off departmental charge any physical loss of cash or stores, debtor balances, claims abandoned, debts irrecoverable by the Crown, nugatory expenditure (meaning thereby any payment of public money involving an immediate and formal loss, or the payment of money in return for which no services have been rendered), or the cash value of issues in kind to any person whomsoever by way of allowance, until the authority of the Assembly has been obtained for the writing off in the annual appropriation Act.

FINES

38 Any accounting officer or any other person subject to these Rules who

commits any breach or who makes any error in any accounts rendered by him, or
who fails to carry out any lawful direction of the Financial Secretary, shall be liable
to a fine not exceeding such amount as may be specified in the Act to be imposed
and to be recoverable as set out in the Act.
APPLICATION OF RULES

39 (1) All money paid to the Postmaster shall be paid into the Post Office

Account, and accounted for under the Regulations and instructions for the time
being in force for the management of the Post Office, subject so far as relates to the
receipt and payment of public money, to the approval of the Financial Secretary.
(2) Subject to this rule, and when not inconsistent therewith, these rules
and any instructions issued by the Financial Secretary shall apply to all persons in
the service of the Post Office.

40 (1) The receipts and payments of all departments of the Government operating outside the Government Account shall be dealt with under any regulations or instructions for the time being in force for the management of these departments, subject so far as relates to the receipt and payment of public money, to the approval of the Financial Secretary.

(2) Subject to the paragraph (1) and when not inconsistent therewith, these Rules and any instructions issued by the Financial Secretary shall apply to all persons in the service of any such department.

390 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

391

TERRITORIAL SEA AND EXCLUSIVE ECONOMIC ZONE

WHALE SANCTUARY REGULATIONS 2003

2003/1 – 14 May 2002

1 Title

These are the Whale Sanctuary Regulations 2003.

2 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations the words and expressions used have the respective
meanings as in the Territorial Sea and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1997.
(2) In these Regulations, ‘cetacean’ includes –
All species of whales;
All species of dolphins; and,
All species of porpoises.

3 Niue Whale Sanctuary

(1) The Whale Sanctuary is established in order to give formal recognition
of the high level of protection already afforded to cetaceans in marine waters of
Niue in accordance with international law.
(2) The Whale Sanctuary comprises the waters of the exclusive economic
zone, the territorial sea and the internal waters as defined in the Territorial Sea
and Exclusive Economic Zone Act 1997.

4 Protection measures

(1) A person is guilty of an offence if the person kills, harms, harasses,
takes or moves any cetacean in the Whale Sanctuary.
(2) A person is guilty of an offence if the person has in his or her possession
any cetacean, cetacean part or cetacean product in the Whale Sanctuary.
(3) Unless evidence is produced to the contrary, any cetacean, cetacean
part or cetacean product found in the possession of a person in the Whale Sanctuary,
is deemed to have been taken in the Whale Sanctuary.
(4) A person is guilty of an offence if the person exports or facilitates the
exportation from Niue of any cetacean, cetacean part or cetacean product.
(5) A person is guilty of an offence if the person imports or facilitates the
importation into Niue of any cetacean, cetacean part or cetacean product.
(6) Any offence under this regulation is punishable on conviction by
imprisonment for not more than 3 months, or a fine not exceeding 2,500 penalty
units, or both.
392 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

5 Non-lethal research permits

(1) The Cabinet may approve the issuance of a permit for the purpose of
non-lethal research intended for the conservation of cetaceans, if the Cabinet is satisfied that the non-lethal research will not result in the killing, harming, harassing, taking or moving of any cetaceans.
(2) The Cabinet may specify conditions in relation to any permit issued
under this regulation.
(3) A person is not guilty of an offence under regulation 4 if the person
carries out an activity authorised by a permit and under the conditions of the
permit.
393

TRANSPORT

TRANSPORT (FEES) REGULATIONS 2005

2005/5 – 24 June 2003

1 Title

These are the Transport (Fees) Regulations 2005.

2 Fees

The fees prescribed for the purpose of the Transport Act 1964 are set out in
the Schedule.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

Driver ’s Licence

Type of Driver ’s Licence

Fee

First Licence Registration

$15.00

Annual Licence

$10.00

Visitor ’s Licence

$10.00

Learner ’s Licence

$5.00

Duplicate Licence (where original is lost or destroyed)

$15.00

Motor Vehicle Registration

Type of Motor Vehicle

Fee

Motor cycle

25.00

Motor cycle for hire

30.00

Motor car, Pickup, Van and Light Truck

35.00

Heavy Trade Motor Vehicles

45.00

Motor Car, Van, Truck and others for hire

60.00

Tractor

25.00

Trailer

20.00

Annual Licence

Fee

Motor Cycle and Motor Cycle for hire

30.00

Motor Car, Van, Pickup, Light Truck

45.00

All vehicles for hire (other than motor cycle)

80.00

Heavy Motor Trade vehicles

80.00

Trailer

10.00

Tractor

25.00

Business Use Vehicles

75.00

Duplicate Licence (where original is lost or destroyed)

10.00

394 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

395

TRUSTEE

TRUSTEES’ COMMISSION RULES 1961

1 These Rules are the Trustees’ Commission Rules 1961.

2 Every application to the Court under section 72 of the Trustee Act 1956, for the allowance to any person who is or has been a trustee of the property subject to any trust or to his personal representative of a commission or percentage out of that property shall be made by motion under the Rules of Court for the time being in force.

3 (1) Every such motion shall be supported by an affidavit or affidavits showing –

(a) How and when the trust was constituted, the names of all present and previous trustees thereof, and the period during which each held office;
(b) Such information as may be necessary to enable an order giving directions as to service to be made;
(c) Particulars of any commission or percentage out of the trust property previously allowed by the Court to, or taken in accordance with the instrument (if any) creating the trust or with the consent of the beneficiaries or otherwise by, each person who is or has been a trustee or the personal representative of a trustee;
(d) Whether any profit, benefit, or advantage has been derived directly
or indirectly by any trustee of the trust property, or by any partner,
relative, servant, or personal representative of any trustee, from or
in connection with the administration thereof; and, if so, particulars
of every such profit, benefit, and advantage;
(e) The amount of the allowance sought by each applicant, and the
basis or principle by which the same is arrived at; and, if an order is
sought under section 72(3) apportioning the total amount allowed,
the basis on which the proposed apportionment is sought;
(f) If the trustees who or whose personal representatives are making
the application have not been the only trustees since the inception
of the trust, information as to the extent to which, up to the date to
which a commission or percentage is applied for, the trust property
has been realised and income got in and the administration of the
trust carried on and its responsibilities discharged by each person
who is or has been a trustee;
(g) If the application is not made at or about the time of the final
distribution of the trust property, sufficient information to enable
the Court to determine what commission or percentage (if any)
should be ordered forthwith having regard to the extent to which
the duties of the trusteeship have already been discharged, and the
period likely to elapse before that final distribution, and the changes
in trusteeship which may occur during that period, and other
relevant facts.
396 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(2) The information referred to in paragraph (1) (b) is such information as may be necessary to enable the Court to decide what persons or classes of persons are interested and by what means the interests of each such person or class of persons may be adequately represented where the questions raised by the motion relate to or affect or may affect –
(a) The interests of several persons under any will, settlement, deed,
instrument of gift, contract, or other instrument, or under any
enactment; or
(b) The interests of infants, or of unborn persons, or of absentees; or
(c) The interests of the inhabitants of any locality represented by a local
authority, or the interests of any similar class of persons; or
(d) The public interest.
(3) With respect to any motion under rule 3 the Court may –
(a) Direct any executor or trustee to represent infants, unborn persons,
or absentees, or persons otherwise unrepresented, or otherwise
provide for such representation;
(b) Direct that a guardian ad litem be appointed to represent any person
where such a course appears necessary;
(c) Direct any person to represent others who have the like interests;
(d) Direct that any party or group of parties appear by a separate
solicitor;
(e) Appoint counsel to represent any party separately as to all or any
questions arising upon the motion, on such counsel undertaking to
represent that party;
(f) –
(g) Direct that the Government Solicitor be served;
(h) Direct that any other Minister or functionary have notice of the
motion;
(i) Direct that, with the consent of a Minister to be filed, any head of a
Government Department or other officer or functionary may
represent the public interest and direct that he be served;
(j) Direct that any local authority, public body, or other representative
body of persons represent the inhabitants of any locality or any
class of persons, unless it appears to the Court that their interests,
or the interests of a considerable section of them, may be adverse to
those of that local authority or public body or other representative
body;
(k) Where a local authority, public body, or other representative body
is itself the party moving, or is a party whose interests appear to
the Court to be adverse to those of the inhabitants or class of persons
represented by that local authority or body or a considerable section
of them, direct in what manner those inhabitants or that class or
that section shall be represented.

4 Subject to rules 5 , 6 and 12 the following documents, duly verified by an

affidavit or affidavits of a solicitor or public accountant, shall be filed in respect of every such motion –
(a) A copy of the will or other instrument (if any) creating the trust; (b) Capital and income accounts of the trust or summarised statements
thereof showing –
(i) The trust property and liabilities at the inception of the trust
and at the date to which a commission or percentage is sought;

Trustee 397

(ii) The gross capital realisations and other capital receipts, and the capital liabilities discharged and investments of capital made, and distributions of capital to beneficiaries and other capital payments made, during the period from the inception of the trust to the date to which a commission or percentage is sought, distinguishing those received and made by the trustees who or whose personal representatives are making the application from those received and made by other trustees (if any);
(iii) The gross income received and liabilities and outgoings discharged from income, and the distributions of income to beneficiaries, and other disbursements from income, during the last-mentioned period, distinguishing those received and made by the trustees who or whose personal representatives are making the application from those received and made by other trustees (if any);
(iv) The sums retained by or paid to solicitors, accountants, auctioneers, land agents, commission agents, brokers, and other agents during the said period in respect of capital and income respectively.

5 (1) Unless the Court or a Judge otherwise orders, the accounts of the trustees

or summarised statements previously kept or made for the purposes of the trust
may be adopted for the purposes of the said motion.
(2) Any information required by rules 3 and 4 and not contained in those
accounts or summarised statements (including any information required in respect
of administration by other trustees) shall be supplied by supplementary accounts
or summarised statements verified in each case by an affidavit of a public
accountant or solicitor.

6 In so far as any information and accounts or summarised statements required in support of any such motion have been supplied in support of any previous application to the Court for a commission or percentage, of these rules shall be deemed to that extent to have been complied with in connection with that motion.

7 The Court may at any time refer the motion or any matter being part thereof or connected therewith to the Registrar for inquiry and report.

8 Unless the Court or a Judge otherwise orders, reasonable notice to the satisfaction of the Registrar of any appointment made by the Registrar to proceed with his inquiry shall be given to every person who was entitled to be served with the motion, unless he has given notice in writing to the Registrar that he does not intend to appear or be represented at the inquiry.

9 The evidence of every witness called on the inquiry before the Registrar shall be taken down in writing and signed by the witness, and shall accompany the Registrar ’s report to the Court.

10 (1) The Court may award costs to any applicant or other person affected by the application, whether any commission or percentage is allowed or not.

(2) If costs are allowed, all usual and proper disbursements, including agency charges, shall, unless the Court or a Judge otherwise orders, also be deemed to be allowed though not expressly mentioned.
398 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

11 The Court may direct that any costs be paid out of the trust property or any part thereof.

12 (1) The Court or a Judge, on motion made before or after the filing of a motion for a commission or percentage, and upon sufficient grounds, may by order dispense with the observance of all or any of the foregoing rules.

(2) A motion under this rule may in the first instance be made ex parte, but the Court or Judge may require notice to be given to such person or persons and in such manner as the Court or Judge may direct.
399

TRUSTEE COMPANIES

[EDITORIAL NOTE: The subsidiary legislation is not reproduced here. It is listed for early repeal.]

400 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

401

UNITED NATIONS

UNITED NATIONS SANCTIONS (TERRORISM SUPPRESSION AND AFGHANISTAN MEASURES) REGULATIONS 2004

2004/5 – 23 September 2003

1 Title

These are the United Nations Sanctions (Terrorism Suppression and
Afghanistan Measures) Regulations 2004.

2 [Spent]

3 Interpretation

(1) In these Regulations –
“Al-Qaida entity” –
(a) Means the Al-Qaida organisation; and
(b) Includes an entity (other than the Al-Qaida organisation)
designated, by or under 1 or more resolutions of the Security Council
relating to Afghanistan, as being an entity associated with Usama
bin Laden and against whom a sanction imposed by those
resolutions and provided for in regulations 6 or 8 is to be imposed;
“entity” means a person, group, trust, partnership, or fund, or an
unincorporated association or organisation;
“funds” –
(a) Means assets of every kind, whether tangible or intangible,
moveable or immoveable, however acquired; and
(b) Includes legal documents or instruments (for example, bank credits,
travellers’ cheques, bank cheques, money orders, shares, securities,
bonds, drafts, and letters of credit) in any form (for example, in
electronic or digital form) evidencing title to, or an interest in, assets
of any kind;
“property” –
(a) Means real or personal property of any description, whether situated
in Niue or elsewhere and whether tangible or intangible; and
(b) Includes an interest in any real or personal property of that kind;
“specified entity” has the meaning given to it in regulation 4;
“Taliban” means the Afghan faction known as the Taliban, which also calls
itself the Islamic Emirate of Afghanistan;
“Taliban entity” means an entity (other than an Al-Qaida entity or the
Taliban or Usama bin Laden) designated, by or under one or more
Resolutions of the Security Council relating to Afghanistan, as an entity
against whom a sanction imposed by those resolutions and provided
for in regulation 6 or regulation 8 is to be imposed.
402 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(2) A reference in these regulations to the transfer of property that is a security includes a reference to a transfer of the security by way of loan, mortgage, pledge, or bailment, whether in respect of a legal or an equitable interest.
(3) The Minister of External Affairs may publish, in any manner that he or she thinks fit (for example, by notice in the Gazette, or publication on the Internet, or both) –
(a) A list of the names, and of any other known identifying details, of entities that are specified entities to whom some or all of the provisions of these Regulations apply;
(b) Any additions to, or deletions from, the list referred to in paragraph
(a).

4 Application

These Regulations apply in respect of the entities referred to in column 1 of
the table in the Schedule to the extent specified in column 2 of that table opposite
the references to those entities, and references in these Regulations to a “specified
entity” must be read accordingly.

5 Collecting or providing funds for specified entities

(1) No person may, directly or indirectly, wilfully and without lawful
justification or reasonable excuse, provide or collect funds intending that they be
used, or knowing that they are to be used, in full or in part, by a specified entity.
(2) In a prosecution for an offence against these regulations of contravening
paragraph (1), it is not necessary for the prosecutor to prove that the funds collected
or provided were actually used, in full or in part, by specified entity.

6 Dealing with property of, or derived or generated from property of, specified entities

(1) No person may, without lawful justification or reasonable excuse, deal with any property knowing that the property is –
(a) Property owned or controlled, whether directly or indirectly, by a specified entity; or
(b) Property derived or generated from any property of the kind specified in subparagraph (a).
(2) Paragraph (1) does not apply if the Minister of Finance has, under
regulation 9, authorised that dealing with the property (for example, to enable a
third party with a valid interest in the property, or in the maintenance or disposition
of it, to obtain relief).
(3) In this regulation “deal with”, in relation to any property –
(a) Means to use or deal with the property, in any way and by any
means, for example, to acquire possession of, or a legal or an
equitable interest in, transfer, pay for, sell, assign, or dispose of
(including by way of gift) the property; and
(b) Includes allowing the property to be used or dealt with, or
facilitating the use of it or dealing with it.

7 Property suspected to be owned or controlled by specified entities to be reported

A person in possession or control of property that the person suspects on reasonable grounds is property that is or may be owned or controlled by, or on behalf of, a specified entity must, as soon as practicable after forming that suspicion, report it to a constable.

United Nations

403

8 Making property, or financial or other related services, available to specified entities

(1) No person may make available, or cause to be made available, directly or indirectly, without lawful justification or reasonable excuse, any property, or any financial or business or professional services, either to, or for the benefit of, a specified entity, knowing that the entity is a specified entity.
(2) An example of a person making property available with a lawful justification, for the purposes of paragraph (1) is where the property the person made available is items of food, clothing, or medicine, that are necessaries of life. (3) Paragraph (1) does not apply if the Minister of Finance has, under regulation 9, authorised that making available of the property or services (for example, to enable a third party with a valid interest in the property, or in the
maintenance or disposition of it, to obtain relief).
(4) In this regulation “make available”, in relation to any property or
services, means to make the property or services available in any way and by any
means (for example, to send, transfer, deliver, or provide the property or services).

9 Minister of Finance may authorise activities or transactions

(1) The Minister of Finance may, by notice in writing, permit any 1 or more
activities or transactions, or classes of activities or transactions, that would
otherwise be prohibited by regulations 6 or 8.
(2) Any authorisation of that kind –
(a) May be subject to terms or conditions; and
(b) May be amended, or revoked, or revoked and replaced.
(3) If a person has obtained an authorisation of that kind, another person
involved in carrying out the activity or transaction or class or classes of activities
or transactions to which the authorisation relates is not subject to regulations 6 or
8.
(4) Paragraph (3) does not apply if –
(a) The authorisation is subject to terms or conditions imposed under
paragraph (2) (a), and
(b) Those terms or conditions are not satisfied.

10 Recruiting members of specified groups

No person may recruit another person as a member of a group or
organisation, knowing that the group or organisation is a specified entity.

11 Participating in specified groups

No person may participate in a group or organisation, knowing that the
group or organisation is a specified entity.

12 Protection of persons

(1) A person has immunity from civil, criminal, or disciplinary proceedings
to the extent provided in paragraphs (2) and (3) if the person –
(a) Acts in purported compliance with the requirements of any of
regulations 6 and 8; or
(b) Reports a suspicion to a constable under regulation 7 (1); or
(c) Discloses information in connection with a report of that kind.
(2) No civil, criminal, or disciplinary proceedings lie against a person to
whom paragraph (1) applies –
404 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4
(a) In respect of the acts of the person in good faith and with reasonable care in purported compliance with the requirements of any of regulations 6 and 8; or
(b) In respect of the report or disclosure, or the manner of the report or disclosure, by that person, of the information referred to in paragraph (1)(b) and (c); or
(c) For any consequences that follow from the report or disclosure of that information.
(3) Paragraph (2)(b) and (c) does not apply if the information was reported
or disclosed in bad faith, or without reasonable care having been taken in
determining, before the report or disclosure, that an entity is a specified entity.

13 Offences

Every person commits an offence against these Regulations, and is liable
accordingly under section 3 of the United Nations Act 1946, who acts in
contravention of or fails to comply in any respect with any of the provisions of
these Regulations.

14 Minister’s consent required for prosecutions

(1) No prosecution for an offence against these Regulations may be
instituted in any court except with the consent of the Minister of External Affairs.
(2) A person alleged to have committed an offence against these Regulations
may be arrested, or a warrant for the person’s arrest may be issued and executed,
and the person may be remanded in custody or on bail, even though the Minister ’s
consent under paragraph (1) has not been obtained.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE (Regulation 4(1)

Specified Entities

Entity Provisions that apply to the entity

Every Al-Qaida entity Every provision of these Regulations

The Taliban Every provision of these Regulations

Every Taliban Entity Every provision of these Regulations

Usama bin Laden Every provision of these Regulations, except regulations

10 and 11.

405

VISITING FORCES

VISITING FORCES (COMMONWEALTH DESERTERS AND ABSENTEES) ORDER 1969

1 Title

This is the Visiting Forces (Commonwealth Deserters and Absentees) Order
1969.

2 Deserters and absentees from Commonwealth forces

Section 5 of the Visiting Forces Act 1939 shall apply to all naval, military,
and air forces of Australia, Canada, Malaysia, Singapore and the United Kingdom.
––––––––––––––––––––

VISITING FORCES ORDER 1966

1 This is the Visiting Forces Order 1966.

2 (1) Each of the following countries is hereby declared to be part of the

Commonwealth for the purposes of the Visiting Forces Act 1939 –
(2) Each of the following countries is hereby declared to be part of the Commonwealth for the purposes of the Visiting Forces Act 1939 as if it were a member of the Commonwealth –
The Republic of Ireland
Samoa
––––––––––––––––––––
406 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

VISITING FORCES (PENAL ARRANGEMENTS) ORDER 1963

1 This is the Visiting Forces (Penal Arrangements) Order 1963.

2 Members of a visiting force, if sentenced by a service court of that part of the Commonwealth to which the force belongs to penal servitude, imprisonment, or detention, may, under the authority of the Minister of Defence given at the request of the officer commanding the visiting force, and, in the case of a person who is to be detained in a prison, with the concurrence of the Minister of Justice, be temporarily detained in custody in prisons or detention barracks in Niue, and, if so sentenced to imprisonment, may, under the like authority and with the like concurrence, be imprisoned during the whole or any part of the term of their sentences in prisons in Niue.

3 The provisions of any enactment, regulations, rules or orders, so far as they relate to or are applied in relation to the reception of prisoners from and their return to the service authorities, their treatment while so imprisoned, the circumstances under which they are to be released, and the manner in which they are to be dealt with in the event of their unsoundness of mind while in such custody or while so imprisoned, shall apply in relation to the members of any visiting force sentenced as aforesaid in like manner as they apply to members of the New Zealand forces of a like nature to the visiting forces sentenced by a service court, subject to the modification that for any reference in any such enactment, regulations, rules, or orders to any service authority of the part of the Commonwealth to which the visiting force belongs, and subject to such other modifications as may be necessary.

––––––––––––––––––––

Visiting Forces

VISITING FORCES (RELATIVE RANKS) REGULATIONS 1971

1971 – 1 November 1971

1 Title

These are the Visiting Forces (Relative Ranks) Regulations 1971.
407

2 For the purposes of section 6 of the Visiting Forces Act 1939, the relative ranks of members of the home forces and of the naval, military, and air forces of the Commonwealth of Australia and the United Kingdom respectively shall be those specified in the Schedule.

–––––––––––––––––––– SCHEDULE
TABLE OF RELATIVE RANKS
408 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

Ordinary Rank

Sapper

Aircraftwoman

Signalman

Cadet Aircrew

Private

Driver

Craftsman

19 Artificer Apprentice

Regular Force Cadet

Aircraft Apprentice

Junior Rank

Airman Cadet

Relative Ranks in Forces Raised in the United Kingdom

Royal Navy

Army and Royal Marines

Royal Air Force

1

Admiral of the Fleet

Field-Marshal

Marshal of the Royal Air Force

2

Admiral

General

Air Chief Marshal

3

Vice-Admiral

Lieutenant-General

Air Marshal

4

Rear-Admiral

Major-General

Air Vice-Marshal

5

Commodore

Brigadier

Air Commodore

6

Captain

Colonel

Group Captain

7

Commander

Lieutenant-Colonel

Wing Commander

8

Lieutenant-Commander

Major

Squadron Leader

9

Lieutenant

Captain

Flight Lieutenant

10

Sub-Lieutenant

Lieutenant

Flying Officer

Acting Sub-Lieutenant (but

junior to Army and Air

Force ranks)

11

Midshipman/Naval Cadet

Second Lieutenant

Pilot Officer

(but junior to all ranks in

Major, Queen’s Gurkha

Acting Pilot Officer

clause 11 of this Schedule

Officer; Captain, Queen’s

(but junior to all ranks in

except Acting Pilot Officer)

Gurkha Officer;

except clause 11 of this

Lieutenant, Queen’s

Schedule except Midshipman)

Gurkha Officer; (but junior

to Air Force ranks)

12

Warrant Officer

Warrant Officer, Class I

Warrant Officer

Regimental Sergeant-Major

Master Pilot

Royal Marines

Master Navigator

Master Signaller Master

Master Engineer Aircrew

Master Air Electronics

Operator

Master Air

Quartermaster

13

Warrant Officer, Class II

Quartermaster Sergeant, Royal

Marines

14

Chief Petty Officer (ranks

Staff Corporal

Flight Sergeant

with Quartermaster Staff

Sergeant

Chief Technician

Sergeant,

Royal Marines, after

9 years’ service as

Chief Petty Officer)

15

Petty Officer

Corporal-of-horse

Sergeant

Sergeant

16

Leading Rating (but junior

Corporal

Corporal

to Army and Air Force

Bombardier

ranks)

Visiting Forces

409

17

Lance-corporal

Lance-bombardier

18 Able Rating

Marine

Junior Technicians

Ordinary Rating

Trooper

Senior Aircraftman

Gunner

Senior Aircraftwoman

Sapper

Leading Aircraftman

Signalman

Leading Aircraftwoman

Driver

Aircraftman

Guardsman

Aircraftwoman

Private

Ranger

Fusilier

Rifleman

Craftsman

19

Relative Ranks in Forces Raised in the Commonwealth of Australia

Royal Australian Navy Australian Military Forces Royal Australian Air Force

1 Admiral of the Fleet Field-Marshal Marshal of the Royal Australian

Air Force

13 Warrant Officer, Class II

410 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4

14

Chief Petty Officer

Staff Sergeant

Flight Sergeant

Chief Wran

Sergeant 1st Class (Naval

Police)

Sergeant 2nd Class (Naval

Police)

15

Petty Officer

Sergeant

Sergeant

Petty Officer Wran

Constable (Naval Police)

16

Leading Seaman

Corporal

Corporal

Leading Wran (but junior to

Bombardier

Army and Air Force ranks)_

17

Lance-corporal

Lance-bombardier

18

Able Seaman

Gunner

Leading Aircraftsman

Wran

Trooper

Leading Aircraftwoman

Ordinary Seaman

Sapper

Aircraftsman

Recruit

Signalman

Aircraftwoman

Private

Aircraftsman (recruit-

Craftsman

19

RAN Apprentice

Officer Cadet, WRAAC

Air Cadet

Recruit Seaman

Cadet Aircrew

Junior Recruit

Trainee Signallers

Aircraft Apprentice

Aircraftwoman (Recruit)

*Ranks in the New Zealand, United Kingdom and Australian women’s forces are shown in the Schedule only where they differ from those in the corresponding male forces. Ranks in the United Kingdom Women’s Royal Naval Service are not shown because the personnel concerned are not subject to the Naval Discipline Act.

NOTE – Officer Cadets: An officer cadet in the New Zealand Army and in the Royal New Zealand Air Force is an appointment, not a rank. New Zealand Army and Royal New Zealand Air Force personnel are normally attested as other ranks and retain that rank during the cadet appointment. Officer cadets are not appointed in the New Zealand Naval Forces.

411

WILDLIFE

WILDLIFE PROTECTED SPECIES NOTICE 1991

1991/9 – 19 November 1991

NOTICE IS HEREBY GIVEN that Cabinet acting under section 3(1) of the Wildlife Act 1972, has declared the species named in the Schedule to be a partly protected species throughout Niue, except for the period commencing on 1 December and ending on 31 December in each year.
––––––––––––––––––––

SCHEDULE

Pigeon (Lupe) Flying Fox (Peka)

412 Niue Laws 2006 Vol 4


Législation Est remplacé(e) par (1 texte(s)) Est remplacé(e) par (1 texte(s))
Aucune donnée disponible

N° WIPO Lex NU003